ATKINS’ PHYSICAL CHEMISTRY This page intentionally left blank ATKINS’ PHYSICAL CHEMISTRY Eighth Edition Peter Atkins Professor of Chemistry, University of Oxford, and Fellow of Lincoln College, Oxford Julio de Paula Professor and Dean of the College of Arts and Sciences Lewis and Clark College, Portland, Oregon W. H. Freeman and Company New York Library of Congress Control Number: 2005936591 Physical Chemistry, Eighth Edition © 2006 by Peter Atkins and Julio de Paula All rights reserved ISBN: 0-7167-8759-8 EAN: 9780716787594 Published in Great Britain by Oxford University Press This edition has been authorized by Oxford University Press for sale in the United States and Canada only and not for export therefrom. First printing W. H. Freeman and Company 41 Madison Avenue New York, NY 10010 www.whfreeman.com Preface We have taken the opportunity to refresh both the content and presentation of this text while—as for all its editions—keeping it flexible to use, accessible to students, broad in scope, and authoritative. The bulk of textbooks is a perennial concern: we have sought to tighten the presentation in this edition. However, it should always be borne in mind that much of the bulk arises from the numerous pedagogical features that we include (such as Worked examples and the Data section), not necessarily from density of information. The most striking change in presentation is the use of colour. We have made every effort to use colour systematically and pedagogically, not gratuitously, seeing as a medium for making the text more attractive but using it to convey concepts and data more clearly. The text is still divided into three parts, but material has been moved between chapters and the chapters have been reorganized. We have responded to the shift in emphasis away from classical thermodynamics by combining several chapters in Part 1 (Equilibrium), bearing in mind that some of the material will already have been covered in earlier courses. We no longer make a distinction between ‘concepts’ and ‘machinery’, and as a result have provided a more compact presentation of thermodynamics with less artificial divisions between the approaches. Similarly, equilibrium electrochemistry now finds a home within the chapter on chemical equilibrium, where space has been made by reducing the discussion of acids and bases. In Part 2 (Structure) the principal changes are within the chapters, where we have sought to bring into the discussion contemporary techniques of spectroscopy and approaches to computational chemistry. In recognition of the major role that physical chemistry plays in materials science, we have a short sequence of chapters on materials, which deal respectively with hard and soft matter. Moreover, we have introduced concepts of nanoscience throughout much of Part 2. Part 3 has lost its chapter on dynamic electrochemistry, but not the material. We regard this material as highly important in a contemporary context, but as a final chapter it rarely received the attention it deserves. To make it more readily accessible within the context of courses and to acknowledge that the material it covers is at home intellectually with other material in the book, the description of electron transfer reactions is now a part of the sequence on chemical kinetics and the description of processes at electrodes is now a part of the general discussion of solid surfaces. We have discarded the Boxes of earlier editions. They have been replaced by more fully integrated and extensive Impact sections, which show how physical chemistry is applied to biology, materials, and the environment. By liberating these topics from their boxes, we believe they are more likely to be used and read; there are end-ofchapter problems on most of the material in these sections. In the preface to the seventh edition we wrote that there was vigorous discussion in the physical chemistry community about the choice of a ‘quantum first’ or a ‘thermodynamics first’ approach. That discussion continues. In response we have paid particular attention to making the organization flexible. The strategic aim of this revision is to make it possible to work through the text in a variety of orders and at the end of this Preface we once again include two suggested road maps. The concern expressed in the seventh edition about the level of mathematical ability has not evaporated, of course, and we have developed further our strategies for showing the absolute centrality of mathematics to physical chemistry and to make it accessible. Thus, we give more help with the development of equations, motivate vi PREFACE them, justify them, and comment on the steps. We have kept in mind the struggling student, and have tried to provide help at every turn. We are, of course, alert to the developments in electronic resources and have made a special effort in this edition to encourage the use of the resources on our Web site (at www.whfreeman.com/pchem8) where you can also access the eBook. In particular, we think it important to encourage students to use the Living graphs and their considerable extension as Explorations in Physical Chemistry. To do so, wherever we call out a Living graph (by an icon attached to a graph in the text), we include an Exploration in the figure legend, suggesting how to explore the consequences of changing parameters. Overall, we have taken this opportunity to refresh the text thoroughly, to integrate applications, to encourage the use of electronic resources, and to make the text even more flexible and up to date. Oxford P.W.A. Portland J.de P. PREFACE vii About the book There are numerous features in this edition that are designed to make learning physical chemistry more effective and more enjoyable. One of the problems that make the subject daunting is the sheer amount of information: we have introduced several devices for organizing the material: see Organizing the information. We appreciate that mathematics is often troublesome, and therefore have taken care to give help with this enormously important aspect of physical chemistry: see Mathematics and Physics support. Problem solving—especially, ‘where do I start?’—is often a challenge, and we have done our best to help overcome this first hurdle: see Problem solving. Finally, the web is an extraordinary resource, but it is necessary to know where to start, or where to go for a particular piece of information; we have tried to indicate the right direction: see About the Web site. The following paragraphs explain the features in more detail. Organizing the information Checklist of key ideas Here we collect together the major concepts introduced in the chapter. We suggest checking off the box that precedes each entry when you feel confident about the topic. Impact sections Where appropriate, we have separated the principles from their applications: the principles are constant and straightforward; the applications come and go as the subject progresses. The Impact sections show how the principles developed in the chapter are currently being applied in a variety of modern contexts. Checklist of key ideas 1. A gas is a form of matter that fills any container it occupies. 2. An equation of state interrelates pressure, volume, temperature, and amount of substance: p = f(T,V,n). 3. The pressure is the force divided by the area to which the force is applied. The standard pressure is p7 = 1 bar (105 Pa). 4. Mechanical equilibrium is the condition of equality of pressure on either side of a movable wall. 5. Temperature is the property that indicates the direction of the flow of energy through a thermally conducting, rigid wall. 6. A diathermic boundary is a boundary that permits the passage of energy as heat. An adiabatic boundary is a boundary that prevents the passage of energy as heat. 7. Thermal equilibrium is a condition in which no change of state occurs when two objects A and B are in contact through a diathermic boundary. 8. The Zeroth Law of thermodynamics states that, if A is in thermal equilibrium with B, and B is in thermal equilibrium with C, then C is also in thermal equilibrium with A. 9. The Celsius and thermodynamic temperature scales are related by T/K = θ/°C + 273.15. 10. A perfect gas obeys the perfect gas equation, pV = nRT, exactly 12. The partial pressure of any gas i xJ = nJ/n is its mole fraction in a pressure. 13. In real gases, molecular interact state; the true equation of state i coefficients B, C, . . . : pVm = RT 14. The vapour pressure is the press with its condensed phase. 15. The critical point is the point at end of the horizontal part of the a single point. The critical const pressure, molar volume, and tem critical point. 16. A supercritical fluid is a dense fl temperature and pressure. 17. The van der Waals equation of s the true equation of state in whi by a parameter a and repulsions parameter b: p = nRT/(V − nb) − 18. A reduced variable is the actual corresponding critical constant IMPACT ON NANOSCIENCE I20.2 Nanowires We have already remarked (Impacts I9.1, I9.2, and I19.3) that research on nanometre-sized materials is motivated by the possibility that they will form the basis for cheaper and smaller electronic devices. The synthesis of nanowires, nanometre-sized atomic assemblies that conduct electricity, is a major step in the fabrication of nanodevices. An important type of nanowire is based on carbon nanotubes, which, like graphite, can conduct electrons through delocalized π molecular orbitals that form from unhybridized 2p orbitals on carbon. Recent studies have shown a correlation between structure and conductivity in single-walled nanotubes (SWNTs) that does not occur in graphite. The SWNT in Fig. 20.45 is a semiconductor. If the hexagons are rotated by 60° about their sixfold axis, the resulting SWNT is a metallic conductor. Carbon nanotubes are promising building blocks not only because they have useful electrical properties but also because they have unusual mechanical properties. For example, an SWNT has a Young’s modulus that is approximately five times larger and a tensile strength that is approximately 375 times larger than that of steel. Silicon nanowires can be made by focusing a pulsed laser beam on to a solid target composed of silicon and iron. The laser ejects Fe and Si atoms from the surface of the ABOUT THE BOOK ix Notes on good practice Science is a precise activity and its language should be used accurately. We have used this feature to help encourage the use of the language and procedures of science in conformity to international practice and to help avoid common mistakes. Justifications On first reading it might be sufficient to appreciate the ‘bottom line’ rather than work through detailed development of a mathematical expression. However, mathematical development is an intrinsic part of physical chemistry, and it is important to see how a particular expression is obtained. The Justifications let you adjust the level of detail that you require to your current needs, and make it easier to review material. Molecular interpretation sections Historically, much of the material in the first part of the text was developed before the emergence of detailed models of atoms, molecules, and molecular assemblies. The Molecular interpretation sections enhance and enrich coverage of that material by explaining how it can be understood in terms of the behaviour of atoms and molecules. q A note on good practice We write T = 0, not T = 0 K for the zero temperature on the thermodynamic temperature scale. This scale is absolute, and the lowest temperature is 0 regardless of the size of the divisions on the scale (just as we write p = 0 for zero pressure, regardless of the size of the units we adopt, such as bar or pascal). However, we write 0°C because the Celsius scale is not absolute. 5.8 The activities of regular solutions The material on regular solutions presented in Section 5.4 gives further insight into the origin of deviations from Raoult’s law and its relation to activity coefficients. The starting point is the expression for the Gibbs energy of mixing for a regular solution (eqn 5.31). We show in the following Justification that eqn 5.31 implies that the activity coefficients are given by expressions of the form ln γA = βxB 2 ln γB = βxA 2 (5.57) These relations are called the Margules equations. Justification 5.4 The Margules equations The Gibbs energy of mixing to form a nonideal solution is ∆mixG = nRT{xA ln aA + xB ln aB} This relation follows from the derivation of eqn 5.31 with activities in place of mole fractions. If each activity is replaced by γx, this expression becomes ∆mixG = nRT{xA ln xA + xB ln xB + xA ln γA + xB ln γB} Now we introduce the two expressions in eqn 5.57, and use xA + xB = 1, which gives ∆mixG = nRT{xA ln xA + xB ln xB + βxAxB 2 + βxBxA 2 } = nRT{xA ln xA + xB ln xB + βxAxB(xA + xB)} = nRT{xA ln xA + xB ln xB + βxAxB} as required by eqn 5.31. Note, moreover, that the activity coefficients behave correctly for dilute solutions: γA → 1 as xB → 0 and γB → 1 as xA → 0. Molecular interpretation 5.2 The lowering of vapour pressure of a solvent in a mixture The molecular origin of the lowering of the chemical potential is not the energy of interaction of the solute and solvent particles, because the lowering occurs even in an ideal solution (for which the enthalpy of mixing is zero). If it is not an enthalpy effect, it must be an entropy effect. The pure liquid solvent has an entropy that reflects the number of microstates available to its molecules. Its vapour pressure reflects the tendency of the solution towards greater entropy, which can be achieved if the liquid vaporizes to form a gas. When a solute is present, there is an additional contribution to the entropy of the liquid, even in an ideal solution. Because the entropy of the liquid is already higher than that of the pure liquid, there is a weaker tendency to form the gas (Fig. 5.22). The effect of the solute appears as a lowered vapour pressure, and hence a higher boiling point. Similarly, the enhanced molecular randomness of the solution opposes the tendency to freeze. Consequently, a lower temperature must be reached before equilibrium between solid and solution is achieved. Hence, the freezing point is lowered. x ABOUT THE BOOK Further information In some cases, we have judged that a derivation is too long, too detailed, or too different in level for it to be included in the text. In these cases, the derivations will be found less obtrusively at the end of the chapter. Appendices Physical chemistry draws on a lot of background material, especially in mathematics and physics. We have included a set of Appendices to provide a quick survey of some of the information relating to units, physics, and mathematics that we draw on in the text. Synoptic tables and the Data section Long tables of data are helpful for assembling and solving exercises and problems, but can break up the flow of the text. We provide a lot of data in the Data section at the end of the text and short extracts in the Synoptic tables in the text itself to give an idea of the typical values of the physical quantities we are introducing. 966 Appendix 2 MATHEMATICAL TECHNIQUES A2.6 Partial derivatives A partialderivativeof a function of more than one variable of the function with respect to one of the variables, all the constant (see Fig. 2.*). Although a partial derivative show when one variable changes, it may be used to determine when more than one variable changes by an infinitesimal a tion of x and y, then when x and y change by dx and dy, res df = y dx + x dy where the symbol ∂ is used (instead of d) to denote a parti df is also called the differential of f. For example, if f = ax3 y y = 3ax2 y x = ax3 + 2by D F ∂f ∂y A C D F ∂f ∂x A C D F ∂f ∂y A C D F ∂f ∂x A C 1000 DATA SECTION Table 2.8 Expansion coefficients, α, and isothermal compressibilities, κT a/(10−4 K−1 ) kT /(10−6 atm−1 ) Liquids Benzene 12.4 92.1 Carbon tetrachloride 12.4 90.5 Ethanol 11.2 76.8 Mercury 1.82 38.7 Water 2.1 49.6 Solids Copper 0.501 0.735 Diamond 0.030 0.187 Iron 0.354 0.589 Lead 0.861 2.21 The values refer to 20°C. Data: AIP(α), KL(κT). Table 2.9 Inversion temperatures, no points, and Joule–Thomson coefficient TI/K Tf /K Air 603 Argon 723 83.8 Carbon dioxide 1500 194.7s Helium 40 Hydrogen 202 14.0 Krypton 1090 116.6 Methane 968 90.6 Neon 231 24.5 Nitrogen 621 63.3 Oxygen 764 54.8 s: sublimes. Data: AIP, JL, and M.W. Zemansky, Heat and New York (1957). 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 0 Potential,/(/)ZrD 0 0.5 Distan 0.3 1 3 f Fig. 5.36 The variation of the shielded C distance for different values of the Deby Debye length, the more sharply the pote case, a is an arbitrary unit of length. Exploration Write an expression f unshielded and shielded Coulom Then plot this expression against rD and interpretation for the shape of the plot. Further information Further information 5.1 The Debye–Hückel theory of ionic solutions Imagine a solution in which all the ions have their actual positions, but in which their Coulombic interactions have been turned off. The difference in molar Gibbs energy between the ideal and real solutions is equal to we, the electrical work of charging the system in this arrangement. For a salt MpXq, we write Gm Gm ideal we = (pµ+ + qµ−) − (pµ+ ideal + qµ− ideal ) = p(µ+ − µ+ ideal ) + q(µ− − µ− ideal ) From eqn 5.64 we write µ+ − µ+ ideal = µ− − µ− ideal = RT ln γ± So it follows that ln γ± = s = p + q (5.73) This equation tells us that we must first find the final distribution of the ions and then the work of charging them in that distribution. The Coulomb potential at a distance r from an isolated ion of charge zie in a medium of permittivity ε is φi = Zi = (5.74) The ionic atmosphere causes the potential to decay with distance more sharply than this expression implies. Such shielding is a familiar problem in electrostatics, and its effect is taken into account by replacing the Coulomb potential by the shielded Coulomb potential, an expression of the form φi = e−r/rD (5.75) Zi r zte 4πε Zi r we sRT 5 4 4 6 4 4 7 5 4 6 4 7 where rD is called the Debye length. Wh potential is virtually the same as the uns small, the shielded potential is much sm potential, even for short distances (Fig. ABOUT THE BOOK xi Comments A topic often needs to draw on a mathematical procedure or a concept of physics; a Comment is a quick reminder of the procedure or concept. Appendices There is further information on mathematics and physics in Appendices 2 and 3, respectively. These appendices do not go into great detail, but should be enough to act as reminders of topics learned in other courses. Mathematics and Physics support Comment 1.2 A hyperbola is a curve obtained by plotting y against x with xy = constant. e n s r e , Comment 2.5 The partial-differential operation (∂z/∂x)y consists of taking the first derivative of z(x,y) with respect to x, treating y as a constant. For example, if z(x,y) = x2 y, then y = y = y = 2yx Partial derivatives are reviewed in Appendix 2. dx2 dx D E F ∂[x2 y] ∂x A B C D E F ∂z ∂x A B C e e 978 Appendix 3 ESSENTIAL CONCEPTS OF PHYSICS Classical mechanics Classical mechanics describes the behaviour of objects in t expresses the fact that the total energy is constant in the ab other expresses the response of particles to the forces acti A3.3 The trajectory in terms of the energy The velocity, V, of a particle is the rate of change of its po V = The velocity is a vector, with both direction and magnit velocity is the speed, v. The linear momentum, p, of a pa its velocity, V, by p = mV Like the velocity vector, the linear momentum vector poi of the particle (Fig. A3.1). In terms of the linear momentu ticle is 2 dr dt p pz px py A3.1 The linear momentum of a particle is a vector property and points in the direction of motion. Illustration 5.2 Using Henry’s law To estimate the molar solubility of oxygen in water at 25°C and a partial pressure of 21 kPa, its partial pressure in the atmosphere at sea level, we write bO2 = = = 2.9 × 10−4 mol kg−1 The molality of the saturated solution is therefore 0.29 mmol kg−1 . To convert this quantity to a molar concentration, we assume that the mass density of this dilute solution is essentially that of pure water at 25°C, or ρH2O = 0.99709 kg dm−3 . It follows that the molar concentration of oxygen is [O2] = bO2 × ρH2O = 0.29 mmol kg−1 × 0.99709 kg dm−3 = 0.29 mmol dm−3 A note on good practice The number of significant figures in the result of a calculation should not exceed the number in the data (only two in this case). Self-test 5.5 Calculate the molar solubility of nitrogen in water exposed to air at 25°C; partial pressures were calculated in Example 1.3. [0.51 mmol dm−3 ] 21 kPa 7.9 × 104 kPa kg mol−1 pO2 KO2 Problem solving Illustrations An Illustration (don’t confuse this with a diagram!) is a short example of how to use an equation that has just been introduced in the text. In particular, we show how to use data and how to manipulate units correctly. xii ABOUT THE BOOK Discussion questions 1.1 Explain how the perfect gas equation of state arises by combination of Boyle’s law, Charles’s law, and Avogadro’s principle. 1.2 Explain the term ‘partial pressure’ and explain why Dalton’s law is a limiting law. 1.3 Explain how the compression factor varies with pressure and temperature and describe how it reveals information about intermolecular interactions in real gases. 1.4 What is the significance of the critical co 1.5 Describe the formulation of the van der rationale for one other equation of state in T 1.6 Explain how the van der Waals equation behaviour. Self-test 3.12 Calculate the change in Gm for ice at −10°C, with density 917 kg m−3 , when the pressure is increased from 1.0 bar to 2.0 bar. [+2.0 J mol−1 ] Example 8.1 Calculating the number of photons Calculate the number of photons emitted by a 100 W yellow lamp in 1.0 s. Take the wavelength of yellow light as 560 nm and assume 100 per cent efficiency. Method Each photon has an energy hν, so the total number of photons needed to produce an energy E is E/hν. To use this equation, we need to know the frequency of the radiation (from ν = c/λ) and the total energy emitted by the lamp. The latter is given by the product of the power (P, in watts) and the time interval for which the lamp is turned on (E = P∆t). Answer The number of photons is N = = = Substitution of the data gives N = = 2.8 × 1020 Note that it would take nearly 40 min to produce 1 mol of these photons. A note on good practice To avoid rounding and other numerical errors, it is best to carry out algebraic mainpulations first, and to substitute numerical values into a single, final formula. Moreover, an analytical result may be used for other data without having to repeat the entire calculation. Self-test 8.1 How many photons does a monochromatic (single frequency) infrared rangefinder of power 1 mW and wavelength 1000 nm emit in 0.1 s? [5 × 1014 ] (5.60 × 10−7 m) × (100 J s−1 ) × (1.0 s) (6.626 × 10−34 J s) × (2.998 × 108 m s−1 ) λP∆t hc P∆t h(c/λ) E hν Worked examples A Worked example is a much more structured form of Illustration, often involving a more elaborate procedure. Every Worked example has a Method section to suggest how to set up the problem (another way might seem more natural: setting up problems is a highly personal business). Then there is the worked-out Answer. Self-tests Each Worked example, and many of the Illustrations, has a Selftest, with the answer provided as a check that the procedure has been mastered. There are also free-standing Self-tests where we thought it a good idea to provide a question to check understanding. Think of Self-tests as in-chapter Exercises designed to help monitor your progress. Discussion questions The end-of-chapter material starts with a short set of questions that are intended to encourage reflection on the material and to view it in a broader context than is obtained by solving numerical problems. ABOUT THE BOOK xiii Exercises and Problems The real core of testing understanding is the collection of endof-chapter Exercises and Problems. The Exercises are straightforward numerical tests that give practice with manipulating numerical data. The Problems are more searching. They are divided into ‘numerical’, where the emphasis is on the manipulation of data, and ‘theoretical’, where the emphasis is on the manipulation of equations before (in some cases) using numerical data. At the end of the Problems are collections of problems that focus on practical applications of various kinds, including the material covered in the Impact sections. max Molarabsorptioncoefficient, Wavenumb ( ) {1= -max ~ max ~ ne e e e n Exercises 14.1a The term symbol for the ground state of N2 + is 2 Σg. What is the total spin and total orbital angular momentum of the molecule? Show that the term symbol agrees with the electron configuration that would be predicted using the building-up principle. 14.1b One of the excited states of the C2 molecule has the valence electron configuration 1σg 2 1σu 2 1πu 3 1πg 1 . Give the multiplicity and parity of the term. 14.2a The molar absorption coefficient of a substance dissolved in hexane is known to be 855 dm3 mol−1 cm−1 at 270 nm. Calculate the percentage reduction in intensity when light of that wavelength passes through 2.5 mm of a solution of concentration 3.25 mmol dm−3 . 14.2b The molar absorption coefficient of a substance dissolved in hexane is known to be 327 dm3 mol−1 cm−1 at 300 nm. Calculate the percentage reduction in intensity when light of that wavelength passes through 1.50 mm of a solution of concentration 2.22 mmol dm−3 . 14.3a A solution of an unknown component of a biological sample when placed in an absorption cell of path length 1.00 cm transmits 20.1 per cent of light of 340 nm incident upon it. If the concentration of the component is 0.111 mmol dm−3 , what is the molar absorption coefficient? 14.3b When light of wavelength 400 nm passes through 3.5 mm of a solution of an absorbing substance at a concentration 0.667 mmol dm−3 , the transmission is 65.5 per cent. Calculate the molar absorption coefficient of the solute at this wavelength and express the answer in cm2 mol−1 . 14.7b The following data were obtained for th in methylbenzene using a 2.50 mm cell. Calcu coefficient of the dye at the wavelength emplo [dye]/(mol dm−3 ) 0.0010 0.0050 0.0 T/(per cent) 73 21 4.2 ll fill d h l Fig. 14.49 Problems Assume all gases are perfect unless stated otherwise. Note that 1 atm = 1.013 25 bar. Unless otherwise stated, thermochemical data are for 298.15 K. Numerical problems 2.1 A sample consisting of 1 mol of perfect gas atoms (for which CV,m = 3 –2R) is taken through the cycle shown in Fig. 2.34. (a) Determine the temperature at the points 1, 2, and 3. (b) Calculate q, w, ∆U, and ∆H for each step and for the overall cycle. If a numerical answer cannot be obtained from the information given, then write in +, −, 0, or ? as appropriate. 2.2 A sample consisting of 1.0 mol CaCO3(s) was heated to 800°C, when it decomposed. The heating was carried out in a container fitted with a piston that was initially resting on the solid. Calculate the work done during complete decomposition at 1.0 atm. What work would be done if instead of having a piston the container was open to the atmosphere? Fig. 2.34 Isotherm 1.00 0.50 Pressure,/atmp 22.44 44.88 Volume, /dmV 3 1 2 3 Table 2.2. Calculate the standard enthalpy of from its value at 298 K. 2.8 A sample of the sugar d-ribose (C5H10O in a calorimeter and then ignited in the prese temperature rose by 0.910 K. In a separate ex the combustion of 0.825 g of benzoic acid, fo combustion is −3251 kJ mol−1 , gave a temper the internal energy of combustion of d-ribos 2.9 The standard enthalpy of formation of t bis(benzene)chromium was measured in a c reaction Cr(C6H6)2(s) → Cr(s) + 2 C6H6(g) t Find the corresponding reaction enthalpy an of formation of the compound at 583 K. The heat capacity of benzene is 136.1 J K−1 mol−1 81.67 J K−1 mol−1 as a gas. 2.10‡ From the enthalpy of combustion dat alkanes methane through octane, test the ext ∆cH7 = k{(M/(g mol−1 )}n holds and find the Predict ∆cH7 for decane and compare to the 2.11 It is possible to investigate the thermoc hydrocarbons with molecular modelling me software to predict ∆cH7 values for the alkan calculate ∆cH7 values, estimate the standard CnH2(n+1)(g) by performing semi-empirical c or PM3 methods) and use experimental stan values for CO2(g) and H2O(l). (b) Compare experimental values of ∆cH7 (Table 2.5) and the molecular modelling method. (c) Test th ∆cH7 = k{(M/(g mol−1 )}n holds and find the 2 12‡ When 1 3584 g of sodium acetate trih About the Web site The Web site to accompany Physical Chemistry is available at: www.whfreeman.com/pchem8 z x y dz2 dx y2 2- dxy dyz dz 10.16 The boundary surfaces of d orbitals. Two nodal planes in each orbital intersect at the nucleus and separate the lobes of each orbital. The dark and light areas denote regions of opposite sign of the wavefunction. Exploration To gain insight into the shapes of the f orbitals, use mathematical software to plot the boundary surfaces of the spherical harmonics Y3,ml (θ,ϕ). It includes the following features: Living graphs A Living graph is indicated in the text by the icon attached to a graph. This feature can be used to explore how a property changes as a variety of parameters are changed. To encourage the use of this resource (and the more extensive Explorations in Physical Chemistry) we have added a question to each figure where a Living graph is called out. ABOUT THE WEB SITE xv Artwork An instructor may wish to use the illustrations from this text in a lecture. Almost all the illustrations are available and can be used for lectures without charge (but not for commercial purposes without specific permission). This edition is in full colour: we have aimed to use colour systematically and helpfully, not just to make the page prettier. Tables of data All the tables of data that appear in the chapter text are available and may be used under the same conditions as the figures. Web links There is a huge network of information available about physical chemistry, and it can be bewildering to find your way to it. Also, a piece of information may be needed that we have not included in the text. The web site might suggest where to find the specific data or indicate where additional data can be found. Tools Interactive calculators, plotters and a periodic table for the study of chemistry. Group theory tables Comprehensive group theory tables are available for down- loading. Explorations in Physical Chemistry Now from W.H. Freeman & Company, the new edition of the popular Explorations in Physical Chemistry is available on-line at www.whfreeman.com/explorations, using the activation code card included with Physical Chemistry 8e. The new edition consists of interactive Mathcad® worksheets and, for the first time, interactive Excel® workbooks. They motivate students to simulate physical, chemical, and biochemical phenomena with their personal computers. Harnessing the computational power of Mathcad® by Mathsoft, Inc. and Excel® by Microsoft Corporation, students can manipulate over 75 graphics, alter simulation parameters, and solve equations to gain deeper insight into physical chemistry. Complete with thought-stimulating exercises, Explorations in Physical Chemistry is a perfect addition to any physical chemistry course, using any physical chemistry text book. The Physical Chemistry, Eighth Edition eBook A complete online version of the textbook. The eBook offers students substantial savings and provides a rich learning experience by taking full advantage of the electronic medium integrating all student media resources and adds features unique to the eBook. The eBook also offers instructors unparalleled flexibility and customization options not previously possible with any printed textbook. Access to the eBook is included with purchase of the special package of the text (0-7167-8586- 2), through use of an activation code card. Individual eBook copies can be purchased on-line at www.whfreeman.com. Key features of the eBook include: • Easy access from any Internet-connected computer via a standard Web browser. • Quick, intuitive navigation to any section or subsection, as well as any printed book page number. • Integration of all Living Graph animations. • Text highlighting, down to the level of individual phrases. • A book marking feature that allows for quick reference to any page. • A powerful Notes feature that allows students or instructors to add notes to any page. • A full index. • Full-text search, including an option to also search the glossary and index. • Automatic saving of all notes, highlighting, and bookmarks. Additional features for lecturers: • Custom chapter selection: Lecturers can choose the chapters that correspond with their syllabus, and students will get a custom version of the eBook with the selected chapters only. • Instructor notes: Lecturers can choose to create an annotated version of the eBook with their notes on any page. When students in their course log in, they will see the lecturer’s version. • Custom content: Lecturer notes can include text, web links, and even images, allowing lecturers to place any content they choose exactly where they want it. Physical Chemistry is now available in two volumes! For maximum flexibility in your physical chemistry course, this text is now offered as a traditional, full text or in two volumes. The chapters from Physical Chemistry, 8e that appear in each volume are as follows: Volume 1: Thermodynamics and Kinetics (0-7167-8567-6) 1. The properties of gases 2. The first law xvi ABOUT THE WEB SITE 3. The second law 4. Physical transformations of pure substances 5. Simple mixtures 6. Phase diagrams 7. Chemical equilibrium 21. Molecules in motion 22. The rates of chemical reactions 23. The kinetics of complex reactions 24. Molecular reaction dynamics Data section Answers to exercises Answers to problems Index Volume 2: Quantum Chemistry, Spectroscopy, and Statistical Thermodynamics (0-7167-8569-2) 8. Quantum theory: introduction and principles 9. Quantum theory: techniques and applications 10. Atomic structure and atomic spectra 11. Molecular structure 12. Molecular symmetry 13. Spectroscopy 1: rotational and vibrational spectra 14. Spectroscopy 2: electronic transitions 15. Spectroscopy 3: magnetic resonance 16. Statistical thermodynamics: the concepts 17. Statistical thermodynamics: the machinery Data section Answers to exercises Answers to problems Index Solutions manuals As with previous editions Charles Trapp, Carmen Giunta, and Marshall Cady have produced the solutions manuals to accompany this book. A Student’s Solutions Manual (0-7167- 6206-4) provides full solutions to the ‘a’ exercises and the odd-numbered problems. An Instructor’s Solutions Manual (0-7167-2566-5) provides full solutions to the ‘b’ exercises and the even-numbered problems. Julio de Paula is Professor of Chemistry and Dean of the College of Arts & Sciences at Lewis & Clark College. A native of Brazil, Professor de Paula received a B.A. degree in chemistry from Rutgers, The State University of New Jersey, and a Ph.D. in biophysical chemistry from Yale University. His research activities encompass the areas of molecular spectroscopy, biophysical chemistry, and nanoscience. He has taught courses in general chemistry, physical chemistry, biophysical chemistry, instrumental analysis, and writing. About the authors Peter Atkins is Professor of Chemistry at Oxford University, a fellow of Lincoln College, and the author of more than fifty books for students and a general audience. His texts are market leaders around the globe. A frequent lecturer in the United States and throughout the world, he has held visiting prefessorships in France, Israel, Japan, China, and New Zealand. He was the founding chairman of the Committee on Chemistry Education of the International Union of Pure and Applied Chemistry and a member of IUPAC’s Physical and Biophysical Chemistry Division. Acknowledgements A book as extensive as this could not have been written without significant input from many individuals. We would like to reiterate our thanks to the hundreds of people who contributed to the first seven editions. Our warm thanks go Charles Trapp, Carmen Giunta, and Marshall Cady who have produced the Solutions manuals that accompany this book. Many people gave their advice based on the seventh edition, and others reviewed the draft chapters for the eighth edition as they emerged. We therefore wish to thank the following colleagues most warmly: Joe Addison, Governors State University Joseph Alia, University of Minnesota Morris David Andrews, University of East Anglia Mike Ashfold, University of Bristol Daniel E. Autrey, Fayetteville State University Jeffrey Bartz, Kalamazoo College Martin Bates, University of Southampton Roger Bickley, University of Bradford E.M. Blokhuis, Leiden University Jim Bowers, University of Exeter Mark S. Braiman, Syracuse University Alex Brown, University of Alberta David E. Budil, Northeastern University Dave Cook, University of Sheffield Ian Cooper, University of Newcastle-upon-Tyne T. Michael Duncan, Cornell University Christer Elvingson, Uppsala University Cherice M. Evans, Queens College—CUNY Stephen Fletcher, Loughborough University Alyx S. Frantzen, Stephen F. Austin State University David Gardner, Lander University Roberto A. Garza-López, Pomona College Robert J. Gordon, University of Illinois at Chicago Pete Griffiths, Cardiff University Robert Haines, University of Prince Edward Island Ron Haines, University of New South Wales Arthur M. Halpern, Indiana State University Tom Halstead, University of York Todd M. Hamilton, Adrian College Gerard S. Harbison, University Nebraska at Lincoln Ulf Henriksson, Royal Institute of Technology, Sweden Mike Hey, University of Nottingham Paul Hodgkinson, University of Durham Robert E. Howard, University of Tulsa Mike Jezercak, University of Central Oklahoma Clarence Josefson, Millikin University Pramesh N. Kapoor, University of Delhi Peter Karadakov, University of York Miklos Kertesz, Georgetown University Neil R. Kestner, Louisiana State University Sanjay Kumar, Indian Institute of Technology Jeffry D. Madura, Duquesne University Andrew Masters, University of Manchester Paul May, University of Bristol Mitchell D. Menzmer, Southwestern Adventist University David A. Micha, University of Florida Sergey Mikhalovsky, University of Brighton Jonathan Mitschele, Saint Joseph’s College Vicki D. Moravec, Tri-State University Gareth Morris, University of Manchester Tony Morton-Blake, Trinity College, Dublin Andy Mount, University of Edinburgh Maureen Kendrick Murphy, Huntingdon College John Parker, Heriot Watt University Jozef Peeters, University of Leuven Michael J. Perona, CSU Stanislaus Nils-Ola Persson, Linköping University Richard Pethrick, University of Strathclyde John A. Pojman, The University of Southern Mississippi Durga M. Prasad, University of Hyderabad Steve Price, University College London S. Rajagopal, Madurai Kamaraj University R. Ramaraj, Madurai Kamaraj University David Ritter, Southeast Missouri State University Bent Ronsholdt, Aalborg University Stephen Roser, University of Bath Kathryn Rowberg, Purdue University Calumet S.A. Safron, Florida State University Kari Salmi, Espoo-Vantaa Institute of Technology Stephan Sauer, University of Copenhagen Nicholas Schlotter, Hamline University Roseanne J. Sension, University of Michigan A.J. Shaka, University of California Joe Shapter, Flinders University of South Australia Paul D. Siders, University of Minnesota, Duluth Harjinder Singh, Panjab University Steen Skaarup, Technical University of Denmark David Smith, University of Exeter Patricia A. Snyder, Florida Atlantic University Olle Söderman, Lund University Peter Stilbs, Royal Institute of Technology, Sweden Svein Stølen, University of Oslo Fu-Ming Tao, California State University, Fullerton Eimer Tuite, University of Newcastle Eric Waclawik, Queensland University of Technology Yan Waguespack, University of Maryland Eastern Shore Terence E. Warner, University of Southern Denmark ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS xix Richard Wells, University of Aberdeen Ben Whitaker, University of Leeds Christopher Whitehead, University of Manchester Mark Wilson, University College London Kazushige Yokoyama, State University of New York at Geneseo Nigel Young, University of Hull Sidney H. Young, University of South Alabama We also thank Fabienne Meyers (of the IUPAC Secretariat) for helping us to bring colour to most of the illustrations and doing so on a very short timescale. We would also like to thank our two publishers, Oxford University Press and W.H. Freeman & Co., for their constant encouragement, advice, and assistance, and in particular our editors Jonathan Crowe, Jessica Fiorillo, and Ruth Hughes. Authors could not wish for a more congenial publishing environment. This page intentionally left blank Summary of contents PART 1 Equilibrium 1 1 The properties of gases 3 2 The First Law 28 3 The Second Law 76 4 Physical transformations of pure substances 117 5 Simple mixtures 136 6 Phase diagrams 174 7 Chemical equilibrium 200 PART 2 Structure 241 8 Quantum theory: introduction and principles 243 9 Quantum theory: techniques and applications 277 10 Atomic structure and atomic spectra 320 11 Molecular structure 362 12 Molecular symmetry 404 13 Molecular spectroscopy 1: rotational and vibrational spectra 430 14 Molecular spectroscopy 2: electronic transitions 481 15 Molecular spectroscopy 3: magnetic resonance 513 16 Statistical thermodynamics 1: the concepts 560 17 Statistical thermodynamics 2: applications 589 18 Molecular interactions 620 19 Materials 1: macromolecules and aggregates 652 20 Materials 2: the solid state 697 PART 3 Change 745 21 Molecules in motion 747 22 The rates of chemical reactions 791 23 The kinetics of complex reactions 830 24 Molecular reaction dynamics 869 25 Processes at solid surfaces 909 Appendix 1: Quantities, units and notational conventions 959 Appendix 2: Mathematical techniques 963 Appendix 3: Essential concepts of physics 979 Data section 988 Answers to ‘a’ exercises 1028 Answers to selected problems 1034 Index 1040 This page intentionally left blank Contents PART 1 Equilibrium 1 1 The properties of gases 3 The perfect gas 3 1.1 The states of gases 3 1.2 The gas laws 7 I1.1 Impact on environmental science: The gas laws and the weather 11 Real gases 14 1.3 Molecular interactions 14 1.4 The van der Waals equation 17 1.5 The principle of corresponding states 21 Checklist of key ideas 23 Further reading 23 Discussion questions 23 Exercises 24 Problems 25 2 The First Law 28 The basic concepts 28 2.1 Work, heat, and energy 29 2.2 The internal energy 30 2.3 Expansion work 33 2.4 Heat transactions 37 2.5 Enthalpy 40 I2.1 Impact on biochemistry and materials science: Differential scanning calorimetry 46 2.6 Adiabatic changes 47 Thermochemistry 49 2.7 Standard enthalpy changes 49 I2.2 Impact on biology: Food and energy reserves 52 2.8 Standard enthalpies of formation 54 2.9 The temperature-dependence of reaction enthalpies 56 State functions and exact differentials 57 2.10 Exact and inexact differentials 57 2.11 Changes in internal energy 59 2.12 The Joule–Thomson effect 63 Checklist of key ideas 67 Further reading 68 Further information 2.1: Adiabatic processes 69 Further information 2.2: The relation between heat capacities 69 Discussion questions 70 Exercises 70 Problems 73 3 The Second Law 76 The direction of spontaneous change 77 3.1 The dispersal of energy 77 3.2 Entropy 78 I3.1 Impact on engineering: Refrigeration 85 3.3 Entropy changes accompanying specific processes 87 3.4 The Third Law of thermodynamics 92 Concentrating on the system 94 3.5 The Helmholtz and Gibbs energies 95 3.6 Standard reaction Gibbs energies 100 Combining the First and Second Laws 102 3.7 The fundamental equation 102 3.8 Properties of the internal energy 103 3.9 Properties of the Gibbs energy 105 Checklist of key ideas 109 Further reading 110 Further information 3.1: The Born equation 110 Further information 3.2: Real gases: the fugacity 111 Discussion questions 112 Exercises 113 Problems 114 4 Physical transformations of pure substances 117 Phase diagrams 117 4.1 The stabilities of phases 117 4.2 Phase boundaries 118 I4.1 Impact on engineering and technology: Supercritical fluids 119 4.3 Three typical phase diagrams 120 Phase stability and phase transitions 122 4.4 The thermodynamic criterion of equilibrium 122 4.5 The dependence of stability on the conditions 122 4.6 The location of phase boundaries 126 4.7 The Ehrenfest classification of phase transitions 129 Checklist of key ideas 131 Further reading 132 Discussion questions 132 xxiv CONTENTS Exercises 132 Problems 133 5 Simple mixtures 136 The thermodynamic description of mixtures 136 5.1 Partial molar quantities 136 5.2 The thermodynamics of mixing 141 5.3 The chemical potentials of liquids 143 I5.1 Impact on biology: Gas solubility and breathing 147 The properties of solutions 148 5.4 Liquid mixtures 148 5.5 Colligative properties 150 I5.2 Impact on biology: Osmosis in physiology and biochemistry 156 Activities 158 5.6 The solvent activity 158 5.7 The solute activity 159 5.8 The activities of regular solutions 162 5.9 The activities of ions in solution 163 Checklist of key ideas 166 Further reading 167 Further information 5.1: The Debye–Hückel theory of ionic solutions 167 Discussion questions 169 Exercises 169 Problems 171 6 Phase diagrams 174 Phases, components, and degrees of freedom 174 6.1 Definitions 174 6.2 The phase rule 176 Two-component systems 179 6.3 Vapour pressure diagrams 179 6.4 Temperature–composition diagrams 182 6.5 Liquid–liquid phase diagrams 185 6.6 Liquid–solid phase diagrams 189 I6.1 Impact on materials science: Liquid crystals 191 I6.2 Impact on materials science: Ultrapurity and controlled impurity 192 Checklist of key ideas 193 Further reading 194 Discussion questions 194 Exercises 195 Problems 197 7 Chemical equilibrium 200 Spontaneous chemical reactions 200 7.1 The Gibbs energy minimum 200 7.2 The description of equilibrium 202 The response of equilibria to the conditions 210 7.3 How equilibria respond to pressure 210 7.4 The response of equilibria to temperature 211 I7.1 Impact on engineering: The extraction of metals from their oxides 215 Equilibrium electrochemistry 216 7.5 Half-reactions and electrodes 216 7.6 Varieties of cells 217 7.7 The electromotive force 218 7.8 Standard potentials 222 7.9 Applications of standard potentials 224 I7.2 Impact on biochemistry: Energy conversion in biological cells 225 Checklist of key ideas 233 Further reading 234 Discussion questions 234 Exercises 235 Problems 236 PART 2 Structure 241 8 Quantum theory: introduction and principles 243 The origins of quantum mechanics 243 8.1 The failures of classical physics 244 8.2 Wave–particle duality 249 I8.1 Impact on biology: Electron microscopy 253 The dynamics of microscopic systems 254 8.3 The Schrödinger equation 254 8.4 The Born interpretation of the wavefunction 256 Quantum mechanical principles 260 8.5 The information in a wavefunction 260 8.6 The uncertainty principle 269 8.7 The postulates of quantum mechanics 272 Checklist of key ideas 273 Further reading 273 Discussion questions 274 Exercises 274 Problems 275 CONTENTS xxv 9 Quantum theory: techniques and applications 277 Translational motion 277 9.1 A particle in a box 278 9.2 Motion in two and more dimensions 283 9.3 Tunnelling 286 I9.1 Impact on nanoscience: Scanning probe microscopy 288 Vibrational motion 290 9.4 The energy levels 291 9.5 The wavefunctions 292 Rotational motion 297 9.6 Rotation in two dimensions: a particle on a ring 297 9.7 Rotation in three dimensions: the particle on a sphere 301 I9.2 Impact on nanoscience: Quantum dots 306 9.8 Spin 308 Techniques of approximation 310 9.9 Time-independent perturbation theory 310 9.10 Time-dependent perturbation theory 311 Checklist of key ideas 312 Further reading 313 Further information 9.1: Dirac notation 313 Further information 9.2: Perturbation theory 313 Discussion questions 316 Exercises 316 Problems 317 10 Atomic structure and atomic spectra 320 The structure and spectra of hydrogenic atoms 320 10.1 The structure of hydrogenic atoms 321 10.2 Atomic orbitals and their energies 326 10.3 Spectroscopic transitions and selection rules 335 The structures of many-electron atoms 336 10.4 The orbital approximation 336 10.5 Self-consistent field orbitals 344 The spectra of complex atoms 345 I10.1 Impact on astrophysics: Spectroscopy of stars 346 10.6 Quantum defects and ionization limits 346 10.7 Singlet and triplet states 347 10.8 Spin–orbit coupling 348 10.9 Term symbols and selection rules 352 Checklist of key ideas 356 Further reading 357 Further information 10.1: The separation of motion 357 Discussion questions 358 Exercises 358 Problems 359 11 Molecular structure 362 The Born–Oppenheimer approximation 362 Valence-bond theory 363 11.1 Homonuclear diatomic molecules 363 11.2 Polyatomic molecules 365 Molecular orbital theory 368 11.3 The hydrogen molecule-ion 368 11.4 Homonuclear diatomic molecules 373 11.5 Heteronuclear diatomic molecules 379 I11.1 Impact on biochemistry: The biochemical reactivity of O2, N2, and NO 385 Molecular orbitals for polyatomic systems 386 11.6 The Hückel approximation 387 11.7 Computational chemistry 392 11.8 The prediction of molecular properties 396 Checklist of key ideas 398 Further reading 399 Discussion questions 399 Exercises 399 Problems 400 12 Molecular symmetry 404 The symmetry elements of objects 404 12.1 Operations and symmetry elements 405 12.2 The symmetry classification of molecules 406 12.3 Some immediate consequences of symmetry 411 Applications to molecular orbital theory and spectroscopy 413 12.4 Character tables and symmetry labels 413 12.5 Vanishing integrals and orbital overlap 419 12.6 Vanishing integrals and selection rules 423 Checklist of key ideas 425 Further reading 426 Discussion questions 426 Exercises 426 Problems 427 13 Molecular spectroscopy 1: rotational and vibrational spectra 430 General features of spectroscopy 431 13.1 Experimental techniques 431 13.2 The intensities of spectral lines 432 13.3 Linewidths 436 I13.1 Impact on astrophysics: Rotational and vibrational spectroscopy of interstellar space 438 xxvi CONTENTS Pure rotation spectra 441 13.4 Moments of inertia 441 13.5 The rotational energy levels 443 13.6 Rotational transitions 446 13.7 Rotational Raman spectra 449 13.8 Nuclear statistics and rotational states 450 The vibrations of diatomic molecules 452 13.9 Molecular vibrations 452 13.10 Selection rules 454 13.11 Anharmonicity 455 13.12 Vibration–rotation spectra 457 13.13 Vibrational Raman spectra of diatomic molecules 459 The vibrations of polyatomic molecules 460 13.14 Normal modes 460 13.15 Infrared absorption spectra of polyatomic molecules 461 I13.2 Impact on environmental science: Global warming 462 13.16 Vibrational Raman spectra of polyatomic molecules 464 I13.3 Impact on biochemistry: Vibrational microscopy 466 13.17 Symmetry aspects of molecular vibrations 466 Checklist of key ideas 469 Further reading 470 Further information 13.1: Spectrometers 470 Further information 13.2: Selection rules for rotational and vibrational spectroscopy 473 Discussion questions 476 Exercises 476 Problems 478 14 Molecular spectroscopy 2: electronic transitions 481 The characteristics of electronic transitions 481 14.1 The electronic spectra of diatomic molecules 482 14.2 The electronic spectra of polyatomic molecules 487 I14.1 Impact on biochemistry: Vision 490 The fates of electronically excited states 492 14.3 Fluorescence and phosphorescence 492 I14.2 Impact on biochemistry: Fluorescence microscopy 494 14.4 Dissociation and predissociation 495 Lasers 496 14.5 General principles of laser action 496 14.6 Applications of lasers in chemistry 500 Checklist of key ideas 505 Further reading 506 Further information 14.1: Examples of practical lasers 506 Discussion questions 508 Exercises 509 Problems 510 15 Molecular spectroscopy 3: magnetic resonance 513 The effect of magnetic fields on electrons and nuclei 513 15.1 The energies of electrons in magnetic fields 513 15.2 The energies of nuclei in magnetic fields 515 15.3 Magnetic resonance spectroscopy 516 Nuclear magnetic resonance 517 15.4 The NMR spectrometer 517 15.5 The chemical shift 518 15.6 The fine structure 524 15.7 Conformational conversion and exchange processes 532 Pulse techniqes in NMR 533 15.8 The magnetization vector 533 15.9 Spin relaxation 536 I15.1 Impact on medicine: Magnetic resonance imaging 540 15.10 Spin decoupling 541 15.11 The nuclear Overhauser effect 542 15.12 Two-dimensional NMR 544 15.13 Solid-state NMR 548 Electron paramagnetic resonance 549 15.14 The EPR spectrometer 549 15.15 The g-value 550 15.16 Hyperfine structure 551 I15.2 Impact on biochemistry: Spin probes 553 Checklist of key ideas 554 Further reading 555 Further information 15.1: Fourier transformation of the FID curve 555 Discussion questions 556 Exercises 556 Problems 557 16 Statistical thermodynamics 1: the concepts 560 The distribution of molecular states 561 16.1 Configurations and weights 561 16.2 The molecular partition function 564 I16.1 Impact on biochemistry: The helix–coil transition in polypeptides 571 The internal energy and the entropy 573 16.3 The internal energy 573 16.4 The statistical entropy 575 CONTENTS xxvii Checklist of key ideas 646 Further reading 646 Further information 18.1: The dipole–dipole interaction 646 Further information 18.2: The basic principles of molecular beams 647 Discussion questions 648 Exercises 648 Problems 649 19 Materials 1: macromolecules and aggregates 652 Determination of size and shape 652 19.1 Mean molar masses 653 19.2 Mass spectrometry 655 19.3 Laser light scattering 657 19.4 Ultracentrifugation 660 19.5 Electrophoresis 663 I19.1 Impact on biochemistry: Gel electrophoresis in genomics and proteomics 664 19.6 Viscosity 665 Structure and dynamics 667 19.7 The different levels of structure 667 19.8 Random coils 668 19.9 The structure and stability of synthetic polymers 673 I19.2 Impact on technology: Conducting polymers 674 19.10 The structure of proteins 675 19.11 The structure of nucleic acids 679 19.12 The stability of proteins and nucleic acids 681 Self-assembly 681 19.13 Colloids 682 19.14 Micelles and biological membranes 685 19.15 Surface films 687 I19.3 Impact on nanoscience: Nanofabrication with self-assembled monolayers 690 Checklist of key ideas 690 Further reading 691 Further information 19.1: The Rayleigh ratio 691 Discussion questions 692 Exercises 692 Problems 693 20 Materials 2: the solid state 697 Crystal lattices 697 20.1 Lattices and unit cells 697 20.2 The identification of lattice planes 700 20.3 The investigation of structure 702 I20.1 Impact on biochemistry: X-ray crystallography of biological macromolecules 711 20.4 Neutron and electron diffraction 713 The canonical partition function 577 16.5 The canonical ensemble 577 16.6 The thermodynamic information in the partition function 578 16.7 Independent molecules 579 Checklist of key ideas 581 Further reading 582 Further information 16.1: The Boltzmann distribution 582 Further information 16.2: The Boltzmann formula 583 Further information 16.3: Temperatures below zero 584 Discussion questions 585 Exercises 586 Problems 586 17 Statistical thermodynamics 2: applications 589 Fundamental relations 589 17.1 The thermodynamic functions 589 17.2 The molecular partition function 591 Using statistical thermodynamics 599 17.3 Mean energies 599 17.4 Heat capacities 601 17.5 Equations of state 604 17.6 Molecular interactions in liquids 606 17.7 Residual entropies 609 17.8 Equilibrium constants 610 Checklist of key ideas 615 Further reading 615 Discussion questions 617 Exercises 617 Problems 618 18 Molecular interactions 620 Electric properties of molecules 620 18.1 Electric dipole moments 620 18.2 Polarizabilities 624 18.3 Relative permittivities 627 Interactions between molecules 629 18.4 Interactions between dipoles 629 18.5 Repulsive and total interactions 637 I18.1 Impact on medicine: Molecular recognition and drug design 638 Gases and liquids 640 18.6 Molecular interactions in gases 640 18.7 The liquid–vapour interface 641 18.8 Condensation 645 xxviii CONTENTS Crystal structure 715 20.5 Metallic solids 715 20.6 Ionic solids 717 20.7 Molecular solids and covalent networks 720 The properties of solids 721 20.8 Mechanical properties 721 20.9 Electrical properties 723 I20.2 Impact on nanoscience: Nanowires 728 20.10 Optical properties 728 20.11 Magnetic properties 733 20.12 Superconductors 736 Checklist of key ideas 738 Further reading 739 Discussion questions 739 Exercises 740 Problems 741 PART 3 Change 745 21 Molecules in motion 747 Molecular motion in gases 747 21.1 The kinetic model of gases 748 I21.1 Impact on astrophysics: The Sun as a ball of perfect gas 754 21.2 Collision with walls and surfaces 755 21.3 The rate of effusion 756 21.4 Transport properties of a perfect gas 757 Molecular motion in liquids 761 21.5 Experimental results 761 21.6 The conductivities of electrolyte solutions 761 21.7 The mobilities of ions 764 21.8 Conductivities and ion–ion interactions 769 I21.2 Impact on biochemistry: Ion channels and ion pumps 770 Diffusion 772 21.9 The thermodynamic view 772 21.10 The diffusion equation 776 I21.3 Impact on biochemistry: Transport of nonelectrolytes across biological membranes 779 21.11 Diffusion probabilities 780 21.12 The statistical view 781 Checklist of key ideas 783 Further reading 783 Further information 21.1: The transport characteristics of a perfect gas 784 Discussion questions 785 Exercises 786 Problems 788 22 The rates of chemical reactions 791 Empirical chemical kinetics 791 22.1 Experimental techniques 792 22.2 The rates of reactions 794 22.3 Integrated rate laws 798 22.4 Reactions approaching equilibrium 804 22.5 The temperature dependence of reaction rates 807 Accounting for the rate laws 809 22.6 Elementary reactions 809 22.7 Consecutive elementary reactions 811 I22.1 Impact on biochemistry: The kinetics of the helix–coil transition in polypeptides 818 22.8 Unimolecular reactions 820 Checklist of key ideas 823 Further reading 823 Further information 22.1: The RRK model of unimolecular reactions 824 Discussion questions 825 Exercises 825 Problems 826 23 The kinetics of complex reactions 830 Chain reactions 830 23.1 The rate laws of chain reactions 830 23.2 Explosions 833 Polymerization kinetics 835 23.3 Stepwise polymerization 835 23.4 Chain polymerization 836 Homogeneous catalysis 839 23.5 Features of homogeneous catalysis 839 23.6 Enzymes 840 Photochemistry 845 23.7 Kinetics of photophysical and photochemical processes 845 I23.1 Impact on environmental science: The chemistry of stratospheric ozone 853 I23.2 Impact on biochemistry: Harvesting of light during plant photosynthesis 856 23.8 Complex photochemical processes 858 I23.3 Impact on medicine: Photodynamic therapy 860 Checklist of key ideas 861 Further reading 862 Further information 23.1: The Förster theory of resonance energy transfer 862 Discussion questions 863 Exercises 863 Problems 864 CONTENTS xxix 24 Molecular reaction dynamics 869 Reactive encounters 869 24.1 Collision theory 870 24.2 Diffusion-controlled reactions 876 24.3 The material balance equation 879 Transition state theory 880 24.4 The Eyring equation 880 24.5 Thermodynamic aspects 883 The dynamics of molecular collisions 885 24.6 Reactive collisions 886 24.7 Potential energy surfaces 887 24.8 Some results from experiments and calculations 888 24.9 The investigation of reaction dynamics with ultrafast laser techniques 892 Electron transfer in homogeneous systems 894 24.10 The rates of electron transfer processes 894 24.11 Theory of electron transfer processes 896 24.12 Experimental results 898 I24.1 Impact on biochemistry: Electron transfer in and between proteins 900 Checklist of key ideas 902 Further reading 903 Further information 24.1: The Gibbs energy of activation of electron transfer and the Marcus cross-relation 903 Discussion questions 904 Exercises 904 Problems 905 25 Processes at solid surfaces 909 The growth and structure of solid surfaces 909 25.1 Surface growth 910 25.2 Surface composition 911 The extent of adsorption 916 25.3 Physisorption and chemisorption 916 25.4 Adsorption isotherms 917 25.5 The rates of surface processes 922 I25.1 Impact on biochemistry: Biosensor analysis 925 Heterogeneous catalysis 926 25.6 Mechanisms of heterogeneous catalysis 927 25.7 Catalytic activity at surfaces 928 I25.2 Impact on technology: Catalysis in the chemical industry 929 Processes at electrodes 932 25.8 The electrode–solution interface 932 25.9 The rate of charge transfer 934 25.10 Voltammetry 940 25.11 Electrolysis 944 25.12 Working galvanic cells 945 I25.3 Impact on technology: Fuel cells 947 25.13 Corrosion 948 I25.4 Impact on technology: Protecting materials against corrosion 949 Checklist of key ideas 951 Further reading 951 Further information 25.1: The relation between electrode potential and the Galvani potential 952 Discussion questions 952 Exercises 953 Problems 955 Appendix 1 Quantities, units, and notational conventions 959 Names of quantities 959 Units 960 Notational conventions 961 Further reading 962 Appendix 2 Mathematical techniques 963 Basic procedures 963 A2.1 Logarithms and exponentials 963 A2.2 Complex numbers and complex functions 963 A2.3 Vectors 964 Calculus 965 A2.4 Differentiation and integration 965 A2.5 Power series and Taylor expansions 967 A2.6 Partial derivatives 968 A2.7 Functionals and functional derivatives 969 A2.8 Undetermined multipliers 969 A2.9 Differential equations 971 Statistics and probability 973 A2.10 Random selections 973 A2.11 Some results of probability theory 974 Matrix algebra 975 A2.12 Matrix addition and multiplication 975 A2.13 Simultaneous equations 976 A2.14 Eigenvalue equations 977 Further reading 978 Appendix 3 Essential concepts of physics 979 Energy 979 A3.1 Kinetic and potential energy 979 A3.2 Energy units 979 xxx CONTENTS Electrostatics 985 A3.11 The Coulomb interaction 986 A3.12 The Coulomb potential 986 A3.13 The strength of the electric field 986 A3.14 Electric current and power 987 Further reading 987 Data section 988 Answers to ‘b’ exercises 1028 Answers to selected problems 1034 Index 1040 Classical mechanics 980 A3.3 The trajectory in terms of the energy 980 A3.4 Newton’s second law 980 A3.5 Rotational motion 981 A3.6 The harmonic oscillator 982 Waves 983 A3.7 The electromagnetic field 983 A3.8 Features of electromagnetic radiation 983 A3.9 Refraction 984 A3.10 Optical activity 985 List of impact sections I1.1 Impact on environmental science: The gas laws and the weather 11 I2.1 Impact on biochemistry and materials science: Differential scanning calorimetry 46 I2.2 Impact on biology: Food and energy reserves 52 I3.1 Impact on engineering: Refrigeration 85 I4.1 Impact on engineering and technology: Supercritical fluids 119 I5.1 Impact on biology: Gas solubility and breathing 147 I5.2 Impact on biology: Osmosis in physiology and biochemistry 156 I6.1 Impact on materials science: Liquid crystals 191 I6.2 Impact on materials science: Ultrapurity and controlled impurity 192 I7.1 Impact on engineering: The extraction of metals from their oxides 215 I7.2 Impact on biochemistry: Energy conversion in biological cells 225 I8.1 Impact on biology: Electron microscopy 253 I9.1 Impact on nanoscience: Scanning probe microscopy 288 I9.2 Impact on nanoscience: Quantum dots 306 I10.1 Impact on astrophysics: Spectroscopy of stars 346 I11.1 Impact on biochemistry: The biochemical reactivity of O2, N2, and NO 385 I13.1 Impact on astrophysics: Rotational and vibrational spectroscopy interstellar space 438 I13.2 Impact on environmental science: Global warming 462 I13.3 Impact on biochemistry: Vibrational microscopy 466 I14.1 Impact on biochemistry: Vision 490 I14.2 Impact on biochemistry: Fluorescence microscopy 494 I15.1 Impact on medicine: Magnetic resonance imaging 540 I15.2 Impact on biochemistry: Spin probes 553 I16.1 Impact on biochemistry: The helix–coil transition in polypeptides 571 I18.1 Impact on medicine: Molecular recognition and drug design 638 I19.1 Impact on biochemistry: Gel electrophoresis in genomics and proteomics 664 I19.2 Impact on technology: Conducting polymers 674 I19.3 Impact on nanoscience: Nanofabrication with self-assembled monolayers 690 I20.1 Impact on biochemistry: X-ray crystallography of biological macromolecules 711 I20.2 Impact on nanoscience: Nanowires 728 I21.1 Impact on astrophysics: The Sun as a ball of perfect gas 754 I21.2 Impact on biochemistry: Ion channels and ion pumps 770 I21.3 Impact on biochemistry: Transport of non-electrolytes across biological membranes 779 I22.1 Impact on biochemistry: The kinetics of the helix–coil transition in polypeptides 818 I23.1 Impact on environmental science: The chemistry of stratospheric ozone 853 I23.2 Impact on biochemistry: Harvesting of light during plant photosynthesis 856 I23.3 Impact on medicine: Photodynamic therapy 860 I24.1 Impact on biochemistry: Electron transfer in and between proteins 900 I25.1 Impact on biochemistry: Biosensor analysis 925 I25.2 Impact on technology: Catalysis in the chemical industry 929 I25.3 Impact on technology: Fuel cells 947 I25.4 Impact on technology: Protecting materials against corrosion 949 This page intentionally left blank PART 1 Equilibrium Part 1 of the text develops the concepts that are needed for the discussion of equilibria in chemistry. Equilibria include physical change, such as fusion and vaporization, and chemical change, including electrochemistry. The discussion is in terms of thermodynamics, and particularly in terms of enthalpy and entropy. We see that we can obtain a unified view of equilibrium and the direction of spontaneous change in terms of the chemical potentials of substances. The chapters in Part 1 deal with the bulk properties of matter; those of Part 2 will show how these properties stem from the behaviour of individual atoms. 1 The properties of gases 2 The First Law 3 The Second Law 4 Physical transformations of pure substances 5 Simple mixtures 6 Phase diagrams 7 Chemical equilibrium This page intentionally left blank The properties of gases This chapter establishes the properties of gases that will be used throughout the text. It begins with an account of an idealized version of a gas, a perfect gas, and shows how its equation of state may be assembled experimentally. We then see how the properties of real gases differ from those of a perfect gas, and construct an equation of state that describes their properties. The simplest state of matter is a gas, a form of matter that fills any container it occupies. Initially we consider only pure gases, but later in the chapter we see that the same ideas and equations apply to mixtures of gases too. The perfect gas We shall find it helpful to picture a gas as a collection of molecules (or atoms) in continuous random motion, with average speeds that increase as the temperature is raised. A gas differs from a liquid in that, except during collisions, the molecules of a gas are widely separated from one another and move in paths that are largely unaffected by intermolecular forces. 1.1 The states of gases The physical state of a sample of a substance, its physical condition, is defined by its physical properties. Two samples of a substance that have the same physical properties are in the same state. The state of a pure gas, for example, is specified by giving its volume, V, amount of substance (number of moles), n, pressure, p, and temperature, T. However, it has been established experimentally that it is sufficient to specify only three of these variables, for then the fourth variable is fixed. That is, it is an experimental fact that each substance is described by an equation of state, an equation that interrelates these four variables. The general form of an equation of state is p = f(T,V,n) (1.1) This equation tells us that, if we know the values of T, V, and n for a particular substance, then the pressure has a fixed value. Each substance is described by its own equation of state, but we know the explicit form of the equation in only a few special cases. One very important example is the equation of state of a ‘perfect gas’, which has the form p = nRT/V, where R is a constant. Much of the rest of this chapter will examine the origin of this equation of state and its applications. 1 The perfect gas 1.1 The states of gases 1.2 The gas laws I1.1 Impact on environmental science: The gas laws and the weather Real gases 1.3 Molecular interactions 1.4 The van der Waals equation 1.5 The principle of corresponding states Checklist of key ideas Further reading Discussion questions Exercises Problems 4 1 THE PROPERTIES OF GASES (a) Pressure Pressure is defined as force divided by the area to which the force is applied. The greater the force acting on a given area, the greater the pressure. The origin of the force exerted by a gas is the incessant battering of the molecules on the walls of its container. The collisions are so numerous that they exert an effectively steady force, which is experienced as a steady pressure. The SI unit of pressure, the pascal (Pa), is defined as 1 newton per metre-squared: 1 Pa = 1 N m−2 [1.2a] In terms of base units, 1 Pa = 1 kg m−1 s−2 [1.2b] Several other units are still widely used (Table 1.1); of these units, the most commonly used are atmosphere (1 atm = 1.013 25 × 105 Pa exactly) and bar (1 bar = 105 Pa). A pressure of 1 bar is the standard pressure for reporting data; we denote it p7 . Self-test 1.1 Calculate the pressure (in pascals and atmospheres) exerted by a mass of 1.0 kg pressing through the point of a pin of area 1.0 × 10−2 mm2 at the surface of the Earth. Hint. The force exerted by a mass m due to gravity at the surface of the Earth is mg, where g is the acceleration of free fall (see endpaper 2 for its standard value). [0.98 GPa, 9.7 × 103 atm] If two gases are in separate containers that share a common movable wall (Fig. 1.1), the gas that has the higher pressure will tend to compress (reduce the volume of) the gas that has lower pressure. The pressure of the high-pressure gas will fall as it expands and that of the low-pressure gas will rise as it is compressed. There will come a stage when the two pressures are equal and the wall has no further tendency to move. This condition of equality of pressure on either side of a movable wall (a ‘piston’) is a state of mechanical equilibrium between the two gases. The pressure of a gas is therefore an indication of whether a container that contains the gas will be in mechanical equilibrium with another gas with which it shares a movable wall. (b) The measurement of pressure The pressure exerted by the atmosphere is measured with a barometer. The original version of a barometer (which was invented by Torricelli, a student of Galileo) was an inverted tube of mercury sealed at the upper end. When the column of mercury is in mechanical equilibrium with the atmosphere, the pressure at its base is equal to that Comment 1.1 The International System of units (SI, from the French Système International d’Unités) is discussed in Appendix 1. Table 1.1 Pressure units Name Symbol Value pascal 1 Pa 1 N m−2 , 1 kg m−1 s−2 bar 1 bar 105 Pa atmosphere 1 atm 101.325 kPa torr 1 Torr (101 325/760) Pa = 133.32 . . . Pa millimetres of mercury 1 mmHg 133.322 . . . Pa pound per square inch 1 psi 6.894 757 . . . kPa High pressure High pressure Low pressure Low pressure Equal pressures (a) (b) (c) Movable wall Motion Fig. 1.1 When a region of high pressure is separated from a region of low pressure by a movable wall, the wall will be pushed into one region or the other, as in (a) and (c). However, if the two pressures are identical, the wall will not move (b). The latter condition is one of mechanical equilibrium between the two regions. 1.1 THE STATES OF GASES 5 q l 1 1 The word dia is from the Greek for ‘through’. exerted by the atmosphere. It follows that the height of the mercury column is proportional to the external pressure. Example 1.1 Calculating the pressure exerted by a column of liquid Derive an equation for the pressure at the base of a column of liquid of mass density ρ (rho) and height h at the surface of the Earth. Method Pressure is defined as p = F/A where F is the force applied to the area A, and F = mg. To calculate F we need to know the mass m of the column of liquid, which is its mass density, ρ, multiplied by its volume, V: m = ρV. The first step, therefore, is to calculate the volume of a cylindrical column of liquid. Answer Let the column have cross-sectional area A; then its volume is Ah and its mass is m = ρAh. The force the column of this mass exerts at its base is F = mg = ρAhg The pressure at the base of the column is therefore (1.3) Note that the pressure is independent of the shape and cross-sectional area of the column. The mass of the column of a given height increases as the area, but so does the area on which the force acts, so the two cancel. Self-test 1.2 Derive an expression for the pressure at the base of a column of liquid of length l held at an angle θ (theta) to the vertical (1). [p = ρgl cos θ] The pressure of a sample of gas inside a container is measured by using a pressure gauge, which is a device with electrical properties that depend on the pressure. For instance, a Bayard–Alpert pressure gauge is based on the ionization of the molecules present in the gas and the resulting current of ions is interpreted in terms of the pressure. In a capacitance manometer, the deflection of a diaphragm relative to a fixed electrode is monitored through its effect on the capacitance of the arrangement. Certain semiconductors also respond to pressure and are used as transducers in solid-state pressure gauges. (c) Temperature The concept of temperature springs from the observation that a change in physical state (for example, a change of volume) can occur when two objects are in contact with one another, as when a red-hot metal is plunged into water. Later (Section 2.1) we shall see that the change in state can be interpreted as arising from a flow of energy as heat from one object to another. The temperature, T, is the property that indicates the direction of the flow of energy through a thermally conducting, rigid wall. If energy flows from A to B when they are in contact, then we say that A has a higher temperature than B (Fig. 1.2). It will prove useful to distinguish between two types of boundary that can separate the objects. A boundary is diathermic (thermally conducting) if a change of state is observed when two objects at different temperatures are brought into contact.1 A p F A Ahg A gh= = = ρ ρ Low temperature High temperature Low temperature High temperature Diathermic wall Energy as heat Equal temperatures (a) (b) (c) Fig. 1.2 Energy flows as heat from a region at a higher temperature to one at a lower temperature if the two are in contact through a diathermic wall, as in (a) and (c). However, if the two regions have identical temperatures, there is no net transfer of energy as heat even though the two regions are separated by a diathermic wall (b). The latter condition corresponds to the two regions being at thermal equilibrium. 6 1 THE PROPERTIES OF GASES metal container has diathermic walls. A boundary is adiabatic (thermally insulating) if no change occurs even though the two objects have different temperatures. A vacuum flask is an approximation to an adiabatic container. The temperature is a property that indicates whether two objects would be in ‘thermal equilibrium’ if they were in contact through a diathermic boundary. Thermal equilibrium is established if no change of state occurs when two objects A to B are in contact through a diathermic boundary. Suppose an object A (which we can think of as a block of iron) is in thermal equilibrium with an object B (a block of copper), and that B is also in thermal equilibrium with another object C (a flask of water). Then it has been found experimentally that A and C will also be in thermal equilibrium when they are put in contact (Fig. 1.3). This observation is summarized by the Zeroth Law of thermodynamics: If A is in thermal equilibrium with B, and B is in thermal equilibrium with C, then C is also in thermal equilibrium with A. The Zeroth Law justifies the concept of temperature and the use of a thermometer, a device for measuring the temperature. Thus, suppose that B is a glass capillary containing a liquid, such as mercury, that expands significantly as the temperature increases. Then, when A is in contact with B, the mercury column in the latter has a certain length. According to the Zeroth Law, if the mercury column in B has the same length when it is placed in thermal contact with another object C, then we can predict that no change of state of A and C will occur when they are in thermal contact. Moreover, we can use the length of the mercury column as a measure of the temperatures of A and C. In the early days of thermometry (and still in laboratory practice today), temperatures were related to the length of a column of liquid, and the difference in lengths shown when the thermometer was first in contact with melting ice and then with boiling water was divided into 100 steps called ‘degrees’, the lower point being labelled 0. This procedure led to the Celsius scale of temperature. In this text, temperatures on the Celsius scale are denoted θ and expressed in degrees Celsius (°C). However, because different liquids expand to different extents, and do not always expand uniformly over a given range, thermometers constructed from different materials showed different numerical values of the temperature between their fixed points. The pressure of a gas, however, can be used to construct a perfect-gas temperature scale that is independent of the identity of the gas. The perfect-gas scale turns out to be identical to the thermodynamic temperature scale to be introduced in Section 3.2c, so we shall use the latter term from now on to avoid a proliferation of names. On the thermodynamic temperature scale, temperatures are denoted T and are normally reported in kelvins, K (not °K). Thermodynamic and Celsius temperatures are related by the exact expression T/K = θ/°C + 273.15 (1.4) This relation, in the form θ/°C = T/K − 273.15, is the current definition of the Celsius scale in terms of the more fundamental Kelvin scale. It implies that a difference in temperature of 1°C is equivalent to a difference of 1 K. A note on good practice We write T = 0, not T = 0 K for the zero temperature on the thermodynamic temperature scale. This scale is absolute, and the lowest temperature is 0 regardless of the size of the divisions on the scale (just as we write p = 0 for zero pressure, regardless of the size of the units we adopt, such as bar or pascal). However, we write 0°C because the Celsius scale is not absolute. B A C Equilibrium Equilibrium Equilibrium Fig. 1.3 The experience summarized by the Zeroth Law of thermodynamics is that, if an object A is in thermal equilibrium with B and B is in thermal equilibrium with C, then C is in thermal equilibrium with A. 1.2 THE GAS LAWS 7 2 Avogadro’s principle is a principle rather than a law (a summary of experience) because it depends on the validity of a model, in this case the existence of molecules. Despite there now being no doubt about the existence of molecules, it is still a model-based principle rather than a law. 3 To solve this and other Explorations, use either mathematical software or the Living graphs from the text’s web site. Comment 1.2 A hyperbola is a curve obtained by plotting y against x with xy = constant. Volume, V Pressure,p Increasing temperature, T 0 0 Fig. 1.4 The pressure–volume dependence of a fixed amount of perfect gas at different temperatures. Each curve is a hyperbola (pV = constant) and is called an isotherm. Exploration3 Explore how the pressure of 1.5 mol CO2(g) varies with volume as it is compressed at (a) 273 K, (b) 373 K from 30 dm3 to 15 dm3 . Illustration 1.1 Converting temperatures To express 25.00°C as a temperature in kelvins, we use eqn 1.4 to write T/K = (25.00°C)/°C + 273.15 = 25.00 + 273.15 = 298.15 Note how the units (in this case, °C) are cancelled like numbers. This is the procedure called ‘quantity calculus’ in which a physical quantity (such as the temperature) is the product of a numerical value (25.00) and a unit (1°C). Multiplication of both sides by the unit K then gives T = 298.15 K. A note on good practice When the units need to be specified in an equation, the approved procedure, which avoids any ambiguity, is to write (physical quantity)/ units, which is a dimensionless number, just as (25.00°C)/°C = 25.00 in this Illustration. Units may be multiplied and cancelled just like numbers. 1.2 The gas laws The equation of state of a gas at low pressure was established by combining a series of empirical laws. (a) The perfect gas law We assume that the following individual gas laws are familiar: Boyle’s law: pV = constant, at constant n, T (1.5)° Charles’s law: V = constant × T, at constant n, p (1.6a)° p = constant × T, at constant n, V (1.6b)° Avogadro’s principle:2 V = constant × n at constant p, T (1.7)° Boyle’s and Charles’s laws are examples of a limitinglaw, a law that is strictly true only in a certain limit, in this case p → 0. Equations valid in this limiting sense will be signalled by a ° on the equation number, as in these expressions. Avogadro’s principle is commonly expressed in the form ‘equal volumes of gases at the same temperature and pressure contain the same numbers of molecules’. In this form, it is increasingly true as p → 0. Although these relations are strictly true only at p = 0, they are reasonably reliable at normal pressures (p ≈ 1 bar) and are used widely throughout chemistry. Figure 1.4 depicts the variation of the pressure of a sample of gas as the volume is changed. Each of the curves in the graph corresponds to a single temperature and hence is called an isotherm. According to Boyle’s law, the isotherms of gases are hyperbolas. An alternative depiction, a plot of pressure against 1/volume, is shown in Fig. 1.5. The linear variation of volume with temperature summarized by Charles’s law is illustrated in Fig. 1.6. The lines in this illustration are examples of isobars, or lines showing the variation of properties at constant pressure. Figure 1.7 illustrates the linear variation of pressure with temperature. The lines in this diagram are isochores, or lines showing the variation of properties at constant volume. 8 1 THE PROPERTIES OF GASES A note on good practice To test the validity of a relation between two quantities, it is best to plot them in such a way that they should give a straight line, for deviations from a straight line are much easier to detect than deviations from a curve. The empirical observations summarized by eqns 1.5–7 can be combined into a single expression: pV = constant × nT This expression is consistent with Boyle’s law (pV = constant) when n and T are constant, with both forms of Charles’s law (p ∝ T, V ∝ T) when n and either V or p are held constant, and with Avogadro’s principle (V ∝ n) when p and T are constant. The constant of proportionality, which is found experimentally to be the same for all gases, is denoted R and called the gas constant. The resulting expression pV = nRT (1.8)° is the perfect gas equation. It is the approximate equation of state of any gas, and becomes increasingly exact as the pressure of the gas approaches zero. A gas that obeys eqn 1.8 exactly under all conditions is called a perfect gas (or ideal gas). A real gas, an actual gas, behaves more like a perfect gas the lower the pressure, and is described exactly by eqn 1.8 in the limit of p → 0. The gas constant R can be determined by evaluating R = pV/nT for a gas in the limit of zero pressure (to guarantee that it is 1/V Pressure,p 0 0 Increasing temperature, T Extrapolation Volume,V 0 Decreasing pressure, p Extrapolation Temperature,T 0 Pressure,p 0 0 Extrapolation Decreasing volume, V Temperature, T Fig. 1.5 Straight lines are obtained when the pressure is plotted against 1/V at constant temperature. Exploration Repeat Exploration 1.4, but plot the data as p against 1/V. Fig. 1.6 The variation of the volume of a fixed amount of gas with the temperature at constant pressure. Note that in each case the isobars extrapolate to zero volume at T = 0, or θ = −273°C. Exploration Explore how the volume of 1.5 mol CO2(g) in a container maintained at (a) 1.00 bar, (b) 0.50 bar varies with temperature as it is cooled from 373 K to 273 K. Fig. 1.7 The pressure also varies linearly with the temperature at constant volume, and extrapolates to zero at T = 0 (−273°C). Exploration Explore how the pressure of 1.5 mol CO2(g) in a container of volume (a) 30 dm3 , (b) 15 dm3 varies with temperature as it is cooled from 373 K to 273 K. 1.2 THE GAS LAWS 9 Table 1.2 The gas constant R 8.314 47 J K−1 mol−1 8.205 74 × 10−2 dm3 atm K−1 mol−1 8.314 47 × 10−2 dm3 bar K−1 mol−1 8.314 47 Pa m3 K−1 mol−1 1 62.364 dm3 Torr K−1 mol−1 1.987 21 cal K−1 mol−1 Comment 1.3 For an object of mass m moving at a speed 1, the kinetic energy is EK = 1–2 m12 . The potential energy, EP or V, of an object is the energy arising from its position (not speed). No universal expression for the potential energy can be given because it depends on the type of interaction the object experiences. behaving perfectly). However, a more accurate value can be obtained by measuring the speed of sound in a low-pressure gas (argon is used in practice) and extrapolating its value to zero pressure. Table 1.2 lists the values of R in a variety of units. Molecular interpretation 1.1 The kinetic model of gases The molecular explanation of Boyle’s law is that, if a sample of gas is compressed to half its volume, then twice as many molecules strike the walls in a given period of time than before it was compressed. As a result, the average force exerted on the walls is doubled. Hence, when the volume is halved the pressure of the gas is doubled, and p × V is a constant. Boyle’s law applies to all gases regardless of their chemical identity (provided the pressure is low) because at low pressures the average separation of molecules is so great that they exert no influence on one another and hence travel independently. The molecular explanation of Charles’s law lies in the fact that raising the temperature of a gas increases the average speed of its molecules. The molecules collide with the walls more frequently and with greater impact. Therefore they exert a greater pressure on the walls of the container. These qualitative concepts are expressed quantitatively in terms of the kinetic model of gases, which is described more fully in Chapter 21. Briefly, the kinetic model is based on three assumptions: 1. The gas consists of molecules of mass m in ceaseless random motion. 2. The size of the molecules is negligible, in the sense that their diameters are much smaller than the average distance travelled between collisions. 3. The molecules interact only through brief, infrequent, and elastic collisions. An elastic collision is a collision in which the total translational kinetic energy of the molecules is conserved. From the very economical assumptions of the kinetic model, it can be deduced (as we shall show in detail in Chapter 21) that the pressure and volume of the gas are related by pV = nMc2 (1.9)° where M = mNA, the molar mass of the molecules, and c is the root mean square speed of the molecules, the square root of the mean of the squares of the speeds, v, of the molecules: c = ͗v2 ͘1/2 (1.10) We see that, if the root mean square speed of the molecules depends only on the temperature, then at constant temperature pV = constant which is the content of Boyle’s law. Moreover, for eqn 1.9 to be the equation of state of a perfect gas, its right-hand side must be equal to nRT. It follows that the root mean square speed of the molecules in a gas at a temperature T must be (1.11)° We can conclude that the root mean square speed of the molecules of a gas is proportional to the square root of the temperature and inversely proportional to the square root of the molar mass. That is, the higher the temperature, the higher the root mean square speed of the molecules, and, at a given temperature, heavy molecules travel more slowly than light molecules. The root mean square speed of N2 molecules, for instance, is found from eqn 1.11 to be 515 m s−1 at 298 K. c RT M / = ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ 3 1 2 1 3 10 1 THE PROPERTIES OF GASES Surface of possible states Pressure,p Volume, V Temperature,T Pressure,p Temperature,T Pressure,p Volume, V p T isochore µ p V1/ isotherm µ V T isobar µ Fig. 1.8 A region of the p,V,T surface of a fixed amount of perfect gas. The points forming the surface represent the only states of the gas that can exist. Fig. 1.9 Sections through the surface shown in Fig. 1.8 at constant temperature give the isotherms shown in Fig. 1.4 and the isobars shown in Fig. 1.6. n p V T Initial Final Same 100 300 500?Same Same Same 2 The surface in Fig. 1.8 is a plot of the pressure of a fixed amount of perfect gas against its volume and thermodynamic temperature as given by eqn 1.8. The surface depicts the only possible states of a perfect gas: the gas cannot exist in states that do not correspond to points on the surface. The graphs in Figs. 1.4 and 1.6 correspond to the sections through the surface (Fig. 1.9). Example 1.2 Using the perfect gas equation In an industrial process, nitrogen is heated to 500 K in a vessel of constant volume. If it enters the vessel at 100 atm and 300 K, what pressure would it exert at the working temperature if it behaved as a perfect gas? Method We expect the pressure to be greater on account of the increase in temperature. The perfect gas law in the form PV/nT = R implies that, if the conditions are changed from one set of values to another, then because PV/nT is equal to a constant, the two sets of values are related by the ‘combined gas law’: (1.12)° The known and unknown data are summarized in (2). Answer Cancellation of the volumes (because V1 = V2) and amounts (because n1 = n2) on each side of the combined gas law results in which can be rearranged into p T T p2 2 1 1= × p T p T 1 1 2 2 = p V n T p V n T 1 1 1 1 2 2 2 2 = 1.2 THE GAS LAWS 11 Table 1.3 The composition of dry air at sea level Percentage Component By volume By mass Nitrogen, N2 78.08 75.53 Oxygen, O2 20.95 23.14 Argon, Ar 0.93 1.28 Carbon dioxide, CO2 0.031 0.047 Hydrogen, H2 5.0 × 10−3 2.0 × 10−4 Neon, Ne 1.8 × 10−3 1.3 × 10−3 Helium, He 5.2 × 10−4 7.2 × 10−5 Methane, CH4 2.0 × 10−4 1.1 × 10−4 Krypton, Kr 1.1 × 10−4 3.2 × 10−4 Nitric oxide, NO 5.0 × 10−5 1.7 × 10−6 Xenon, Xe 8.7 × 10−6 1.2 × 10−5 Ozone, O3: summer 7.0 × 10−6 1.2 × 10−5 winter 2.0 × 10−6 3.3 × 10−6 Substitution of the data then gives Experiment shows that the pressure is actually 183 atm under these conditions, so the assumption that the gas is perfect leads to a 10 per cent error. Self-test 1.3 What temperature would result in the same sample exerting a pressure of 300 atm? [900 K] The perfect gas equation is of the greatest importance in physical chemistry because it is used to derive a wide range of relations that are used throughout thermodynamics. However, it is also of considerable practical utility for calculating the properties of a gas under a variety of conditions. For instance, the molar volume, Vm = V/n, of a perfect gas under the conditions called standard ambient temperature and pressure (SATP), which means 298.15 K and 1 bar (that is, exactly 105 Pa), is easily calculated from Vm = RT/p to be 24.789 dm3 mol−1 . An earlier definition, standard temperature and pressure (STP), was 0°C and 1 atm; at STP, the molar volume of a perfect gas is 22.414 dm3 mol−1 . Among other applications, eqn 1.8 can be used to discuss processes in the atmosphere that give rise to the weather. IMPACT ON ENVIRONMENTAL SCIENCE I1.1 The gas laws and the weather The biggest sample of gas readily accessible to us is the atmosphere, a mixture of gases with the composition summarized in Table 1.3. The composition is maintained moderately constant by diffusion and convection (winds, particularly the local turbulence called eddies) but the pressure and temperature vary with altitude and with the local conditions, particularly in the troposphere (the ‘sphere of change’), the layer extending up to about 11 km. p2 500 300 100 167( )= × = K K atm atm 12 1 THE PROPERTIES OF GASES In the troposphere the average temperature is 15°C at sea level, falling to –57°C at the bottom of the tropopause at 11 km. This variation is much less pronounced when expressed on the Kelvin scale, ranging from 288 K to 216 K, an average of 268 K. If we suppose that the temperature has its average value all the way up to the tropopause, then the pressure varies with altitude, h, according to the barometric formula: p = p0e−h/H where p0 is the pressure at sea level and H is a constant approximately equal to 8 km. More specifically, H = RT/Mg, where M is the average molar mass of air and T is the temperature. The barometric formula fits the observed pressure distribution quite well even for regions well above the troposphere (see Fig. 1.10). It implies that the pressure of the air and its density fall to half their sea-level value at h = H ln 2, or 6 km. Local variations of pressure, temperature, and composition in the troposphere are manifest as ‘weather’. A small region of air is termed a parcel. First, we note that a parcel of warm air is less dense than the same parcel of cool air. As a parcel rises, it expands adiabatically (that is, without transfer of heat from its surroundings), so it cools. Cool air can absorb lower concentrations of water vapour than warm air, so the moisture forms clouds. Cloudy skies can therefore be associated with rising air and clear skies are often associated with descending air. The motion of air in the upper altitudes may lead to an accumulation in some regions and a loss of molecules from other regions. The former result in the formation of regions of high pressure (‘highs’ or anticyclones) and the latter result in regions of low pressure (‘lows’, depressions, or cyclones). These regions are shown as H and L on the accompanying weather map (Fig. 1.11). The lines of constant pressure—differing by 4 mbar (400 Pa, about 3 Torr)—marked on it are called isobars. The elongated regions of high and low pressure are known, respectively, as ridges and troughs. In meteorology, large-scale vertical movement is called convection. Horizontal pressure differentials result in the flow of air that we call wind (see Fig.1.12). Winds coming from the north in the Northern hemisphere and from the south in the Southern hemisphere are deflected towards the west as they migrate from a region where the Earth is rotating slowly (at the poles) to where it is rotating most rapidly (at the equator). Winds travel nearly parallel to the isobars, with low pressure to their left in the Northern hemisphere and to the right in the Southern hemisphere. At the surface, where wind speeds are lower, the winds tend to travel perpendicular to the isobars from high to low pressure. This differential motion results in a spiral outward flow of air clockwise in the Northern hemisphere around a high and an inward counterclockwise flow around a low. The air lost from regions of high pressure is restored as an influx of air converges into the region and descends. As we have seen, descending air is associated with clear skies. It also becomes warmer by compression as it descends, so regions of high pressure are associated with high surface temperatures. In winter, the cold surface air may prevent the complete fall of air, and result in a temperature inversion, with a layer of warm air over a layer of cold air. Geographical conditions may also trap cool air, as in Los Angeles, and the photochemical pollutants we know as smog may be trapped under the warm layer. (b) Mixtures of gases When dealing with gaseous mixtures, we often need to know the contribution that each component makes to the total pressure of the sample. The partialpressure, pJ, of a gas J in a mixture (any gas, not just a perfect gas), is defined as pJ = xJp [1.13] p0 Pressure, p 0 Altitude,/kmh 6 10 15 20 30 0 H L H H H Fig. 1.10 The variation of atmospheric pressure with altitude, as predicted by the barometric formula and as suggested by the ‘US Standard Atmosphere’, which takes into account the variation of temperature with altitude. Exploration How would the graph shown in the illustration change if the temperature variation with altitude were taken into account? Construct a graph allowing for a linear decrease in temperature with altitude. Fig. 1.11 A typical weather map; in this case, for the United States on 1 January 2000. L L Wind Rotation N S Fig. 1.12 The flow of air (‘wind’) around regions of high and low pressure in the Northern and Southern hemispheres. 1.2 THE GAS LAWS 13 where xJ is the mole fraction of the component J, the amount of J expressed as a fraction of the total amount of molecules, n, in the sample: n = nA + nB + · · · [1.14] When no J molecules are present, xJ = 0; when only J molecules are present, xJ = 1. It follows from the definition of xJ that, whatever the composition of the mixture, xA + xB + · · · = 1 and therefore that the sum of the partial pressures is equal to the total pressure: pA + pB + · · · = (xA + xB + · · · )p = p (1.15) This relation is true for both real and perfect gases. When all the gases are perfect, the partial pressure as defined in eqn 1.13 is also the pressure that each gas would occupy if it occupied the same container alone at the same temperature. The latter is the original meaning of ‘partial pressure’. That identification was the basis of the original formulation of Dalton’s law: The pressure exerted by a mixture of gases is the sum of the pressures that each one would exist if it occupied the container alone. Now, however, the relation between partial pressure (as defined in eqn 1.13) and total pressure (as given by eqn 1.15) is true for all gases and the identification of partial pressure with the pressure that the gas would exert on its own is valid only for a perfect gas. Example 1.3 Calculating partial pressures The mass percentage composition of dry air at sea level is approximately N2: 75.5; O2: 23.2; Ar: 1.3. What is the partial pressure of each component when the total pressure is 1.00 atm? Method We expect species with a high mole fraction to have a proportionally high partial pressure. Partial pressures are defined by eqn 1.13. To use the equation, we need the mole fractions of the components. To calculate mole fractions, which are defined by eqn 1.14, we use the fact that the amount of molecules J of molar mass MJ in a sample of mass mJ is nJ = mJ/MJ. The mole fractions are independent of the total mass of the sample, so we can choose the latter to be 100 g (which makes the conversion from mass percentages very easy). Thus, the mass of N2 present is 75.5 per cent of 100 g, which is 75.5 g. Answer The amounts of each type of molecule present in 100 g of air, in which the masses of N2, O2, and Ar are 75.5 g, 23.2 g, and 1.3 g, respectively, are These three amounts work out as 2.69 mol, 0.725 mol, and 0.033 mol, respectively, for a total of 3.45 mol. The mole fractions are obtained by dividing each of the n( ) . . . . Ar g g mol mol= =− 1 3 39 95 1 3 39 951 n( ) . . . . O g g mol mol2 1 23 2 32 00 23 2 32 00 = =− n( ) . . . . N g g mol mol2 1 75 5 28 02 75 5 28 02 = =− x n n J J = 14 1 THE PROPERTIES OF GASES Separation Potentialenergy 0 Contact Attractions dominant Repulsionsdominant Fig. 1.13 The variation of the potential energy of two molecules on their separation. High positive potential energy (at very small separations) indicates that the interactions between them are strongly repulsive at these distances. At intermediate separations, where the potential energy is negative, the attractive interactions dominate. At large separations (on the right) the potential energy is zero and there is no interaction between the molecules. above amounts by 3.45 mol and the partial pressures are then obtained by multiplying the mole fraction by the total pressure (1.00 atm): N2 O2 Ar Mole fraction: 0.780 0.210 0.0096 Partial pressure/atm: 0.780 0.210 0.0096 We have not had to assume that the gases are perfect: partial pressures are defined as pJ = xJp for any kind of gas. Self-test 1.4 When carbon dioxide is taken into account, the mass percentages are 75.52 (N2), 23.15 (O2), 1.28 (Ar), and 0.046 (CO2). What are the partial pressures when the total pressure is 0.900 atm? [0.703, 0.189, 0.0084, 0.00027 atm] Real gases Real gases do not obey the perfect gas law exactly. Deviations from the law are particularly important at high pressures and low temperatures, especially when a gas is on the point of condensing to liquid. 1.3 Molecular interactions Real gases show deviations from the perfect gas law because molecules interact with one another. Repulsive forces between molecules assist expansion and attractive forces assist compression. Repulsive forces are significant only when molecules are almost in contact: they are short-range interactions, even on a scale measured in molecular diameters (Fig. 1.13). Because they are short-range interactions, repulsions can be expected to be important only when the average separation of the molecules is small. This is the case at high pressure, when many molecules occupy a small volume. On the other hand, attractive intermolecular forces have a relatively long range and are effective over several molecular diameters. They are important when the molecules are fairly close together but not necessarily touching (at the intermediate separations in Fig. 1.13). Attractive forces are ineffective when the molecules are far apart (well to the right in Fig. 1.13). Intermolecular forces are also important when the temperature is so low that the molecules travel with such low mean speeds that they can be captured by one another. At low pressures, when the sample occupies a large volume, the molecules are so far apart for most of the time that the intermolecular forces play no significant role, and the gas behaves virtually perfectly. At moderate pressures, when the average separation of the molecules is only a few molecular diameters, the attractive forces dominate the repulsive forces. In this case, the gas can be expected to be more compressible than a perfect gas because the forces help to draw the molecules together. At high pressures, when the average separation of the molecules is small, the repulsive forces dominate and the gas can be expected to be less compressible because now the forces help to drive the molecules apart. (a) The compression factor The compression factor, Z, of a gas is the ratio of its measured molar volume, Vm = V/n, to the molar volume of a perfect gas, Vo m, at the same pressure and temperature: 1.3 MOLECULAR INTERACTIONS 15 [1.16] Because the molar volume of a perfect gas is equal to RT/p, an equivalent expression is Z = RT/pV o m, which we can write as pVm = RTZ (1.17) Because for a perfect gas Z = 1 under all conditions, deviation of Z from 1 is a measure of departure from perfect behaviour. Some experimental values of Z are plotted in Fig. 1.14. At very low pressures, all the gases shown have Z ≈ 1 and behave nearly perfectly. At high pressures, all the gases have Z > 1, signifying that they have a larger molar volume than a perfect gas. Repulsive forces are now dominant. At intermediate pressures, most gases have Z < 1, indicating that the attractive forces are reducing the molar volume relative to that of a perfect gas. (b) Virial coefficients Figure 1.15 shows the experimental isotherms for carbon dioxide. At large molar volumes and high temperatures the real-gas isotherms do not differ greatly from perfect-gas isotherms. The small differences suggest that the perfect gas law is in fact the first term in an expression of the form pVm = RT(1 + B′p + C′p2 + · · · ) (1.18) This expression is an example of a common procedure in physical chemistry, in which a simple law that is known to be a good first approximation (in this case pV = nRT) is Z V V = m m o H2 CH4 C H2 4 NH3 p/atm 2 1 0 200 400 600 800 Perfect 0 Compressionfactor,Z 1.00 0.98 0.96 10 H2 CH4 C H2 4 NH3 p/atm 140 120 100 80 60 40 20 0 0 0.2 0.4 0.6 50°C 40°C 31.04°C ( )Tc 0°C p/atm Vm /(dm mol ) 3 1 E D C B A F * 20°C Fig. 1.14 The variation of the compression factor, Z, with pressure for several gases at 0°C. A perfect gas has Z = 1 at all pressures. Notice that, although the curves approach 1 as p → 0, they do so with different slopes. Fig. 1.15 Experimental isotherms of carbon dioxide at several temperatures. The ‘critical isotherm’, the isotherm at the critical temperature, is at 31.04°C. The critical point is marked with a star. 16 1 THE PROPERTIES OF GASES treated as the first term in a series in powers of a variable (in this case p). A more convenient expansion for many applications is (1.19) These two expressions are two versions of the virial equation of state.4 By comparing the expression with eqn 1.17 we see that the term in parentheses can be identified with the compression factor, Z. The coefficients B, C, . . . , which depend on the temperature, are the second, third, . . . virial coefficients (Table 1.4); the first virial coefficient is 1. The third virial coefficient, C, is usually less important than the second coefficient, B, in the sense that at typical molar volumes C/V2 m << B/Vm. We can use the virial equation to demonstrate the important point that, although the equation of state of a real gas may coincide with the perfect gas law as p → 0, not all its properties necessarily coincide with those of a perfect gas in that limit. Consider, for example, the value of dZ/dp, the slope of the graph of compression factor against pressure. For a perfect gas dZ/dp = 0 (because Z = 1 at all pressures), but for a real gas from eqn 1.18 we obtain + 2pC′ + · · · → B′ as p → 0 (1.20a) However, B′ is not necessarily zero, so the slope of Z with respect to p does not necessarily approach 0 (the perfect gas value), as we can see in Fig. 1.14. Because several physical properties of gases depend on derivatives, the properties of real gases do not always coincide with the perfect gas values at low pressures. By a similar argument, → B as Vm → ∞, corresponding to p → 0 (1.20b) Because the virial coefficients depend on the temperature, there may be a temperature at which Z → 1 with zero slope at low pressure or high molar volume (Fig. 1.16). At this temperature, which is called the Boyle temperature, TB, the properties of the real gas do coincide with those of a perfect gas as p → 0. According to eqn 1.20b, Z has zero slope as p → 0 if B = 0, so we can conclude that B = 0 at the Boyle temperature. It then follows from eqn 1.19 that pVm ≈ RTB over a more extended range of pressures than at other temperatures because the first term after 1 (that is, B/Vm) in the virial equation is zero and C/V2 m and higher terms are negligibly small. For helium TB = 22.64 K; for air TB = 346.8 K; more values are given in Table 1.5. d d m Z V( / )1 d d Z p B= ′ pV RT B V C V m m m = + + + ⋅ ⋅ ⋅ ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟1 2 Comment 1.4 Series expansions are discussed in Appendix 2. 4 The name comes from the Latin word for force. The coefficients are sometimes denoted B2, B3, . . . . Synoptic Table 1.4* Second virial coefficients, B/(cm3 mol−1 ) Temperature 273 K 600 K Ar −21.7 11.9 CO2 −149.7 −12.4 N2 −10.5 21.7 Xe −153.7 −19.6 * More values are given in the Data section. Synoptic Table 1.5* Critical constants of gases pc/atm Vc/(cm3 mol−1 ) Tc/K Zc TB/K Ar 48.0 75.3 150.7 0.292 411.5 CO2 72.9 94.0 304.2 0.274 714.8 He 2.26 57.8 5.2 0.305 22.64 O2 50.14 78.0 154.8 0.308 405.9 * More values are given in the Data section. Pressure, p Higher temperature Lower temperature Perfect gas Boyle temperature 1 Compressionfactor,Z 0 Fig. 1.16 The compression factor, Z, approaches 1 at low pressures, but does so with different slopes. For a perfect gas, the slope is zero, but real gases may have either positive or negative slopes, and the slope may vary with temperature. At the Boyle temperature, the slope is zero and the gas behaves perfectly over a wider range of conditions than at other temperatures. 1.4 THE VAN DER WAALS EQUATION 17 (c) Condensation Now consider what happens when we compress a sample of gas initially in the state marked A in Fig. 1.15 at constant temperature (by pushing in a piston). Near A, the pressure of the gas rises in approximate agreement with Boyle’s law. Serious deviations from that law begin to appear when the volume has been reduced to B. At C (which corresponds to about 60 atm for carbon dioxide), all similarity to perfect behaviour is lost, for suddenly the piston slides in without any further rise in pressure: this stage is represented by the horizontal line CDE. Examination of the contents of the vessel shows that just to the left of C a liquid appears, and there are two phases separated by a sharply defined surface. As the volume is decreased from C through D to E, the amount of liquid increases. There is no additional resistance to the piston because the gas can respond by condensing. The pressure corresponding to the line CDE, when both liquid and vapour are present in equilibrium, is called the vapour pressure of the liquid at the temperature of the experiment. At E, the sample is entirely liquid and the piston rests on its surface. Any further reduction of volume requires the exertion of considerable pressure, as is indicated by the sharply rising line to the left of E. Even a small reduction of volume from E to F requires a great increase in pressure. (d) Critical constants The isotherm at the temperature Tc (304.19 K, or 31.04°C for CO2) plays a special role in the theory of the states of matter. An isotherm slightly below Tc behaves as we have already described: at a certain pressure, a liquid condenses from the gas and is distinguishable from it by the presence of a visible surface. If, however, the compression takes place at Tc itself, then a surface separating two phases does not appear and the volumes at each end of the horizontal part of the isotherm have merged to a single point, the critical point of the gas. The temperature, pressure, and molar volume at the critical point are called the critical temperature, Tc, critical pressure, pc, and critical molar volume, Vc, of the substance. Collectively, pc, Vc, and Tc are the critical constants of a substance (Table 1.5). At and above Tc, the sample has a single phase that occupies the entire volume of the container. Such a phase is, by definition, a gas. Hence, the liquid phase of a substance does not form above the critical temperature. The critical temperature of oxygen, for instance, signifies that it is impossible to produce liquid oxygen by compression alone if its temperature is greater than 155 K: to liquefy oxygen—to obtain a fluid phase that does not occupy the entire volume—the temperature must first be lowered to below 155 K, and then the gas compressed isothermally. The single phase that fills the entire volume when T > Tc may be much denser than we normally consider typical of gases, and the name supercritical fluid is preferred. 1.4 The van der Waals equation We can draw conclusions from the virial equations of state only by inserting specific values of the coefficients. It is often useful to have a broader, if less precise, view of all gases. Therefore, we introduce the approximate equation of state suggested by J.D. van der Waals in 1873. This equation is an excellent example of an expression that can be obtained by thinking scientifically about a mathematically complicated but physically simple problem, that is, it is a good example of ‘model building’. The van der Waals equation is (1.21a)p nRT V nb a n V = − − ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ 2 Comment 1.5 The web site contains links to online databases of properties of gases. 18 1 THE PROPERTIES OF GASES Synoptic Table 1.6* van der Waals coefficients a/(atm dm6 mol−2 ) b/(10−2 dm3 mol−1 ) Ar 1.337 3.20 CO2 3.610 4.29 He 0.0341 2.38 Xe 4.137 5.16 * More values are given in the Data section. and a derivation is given in Justification 1.1. The equation is often written in terms of the molar volume Vm = V/n as (1.21b) The constants a and b are called the van der Waals coefficients. They are characteristic of each gas but independent of the temperature (Table 1.6). Justification 1.1 The van der Waals equation of state The repulsive interactions between molecules are taken into account by supposing that they cause the molecules to behave as small but impenetrable spheres. The nonzero volume of the molecules implies that instead of moving in a volume V they are restricted to a smaller volume V − nb, where nb is approximately the total volume taken up by the molecules themselves. This argument suggests that the perfect gas law p = nRT/V should be replaced by when repulsions are significant. The closest distance of two hard-sphere molecules of radius r, and volume Vmolecule = , is 2r, so the volume excluded is (2r)3 , or 8Vmolecule. The volume excluded per molecule is one-half this volume, or 4Vmolecule, so b ≈ 4VmoleculeNA. The pressure depends on both the frequency of collisions with the walls and the force of each collision. Both the frequency of the collisions and their force are reduced by the attractive forces, which act with a strength proportional to the molar concentration, n/V, of molecules in the sample. Therefore, because both the frequency and the force of the collisions are reduced by the attractive forces, the pressure is reduced in proportion to the square of this concentration. If the reduction of pressure is written as −a(n/V)2 , where a is a positive constant characteristic of each gas, the combined effect of the repulsive and attractive forces is the van der Waals equation of state as expressed in eqn 1.21. In this Justification we have built the van der Waals equation using vague arguments about the volumes of molecules and the effects of forces. The equation can be derived in other ways, but the present method has the advantage that it shows how to derive the form of an equation out of general ideas. The derivation also has the advantage of keeping imprecise the significance of the coefficients a and b: they are much better regarded as empirical parameters than as precisely defined molecular properties. Example 1.4 Using the van der Waals equation to estimate a molar volume Estimate the molar volume of CO2 at 500 K and 100 atm by treating it as a van der Waals gas. Method To express eqn 1.21b as an equation for the molar volume, we multiply both sides by (Vm – b)V2 m, to obtain (Vm – b)V2 mp = RTV2 m – (Vm – b)a and, after division by p, collect powers of Vm to obtain V b RT p V a p V ab pm m m 3 2 0− + ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ + ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ − = 4 3 π4 3 3πr p nRT V nb = − p RT V b a V = − − m m 2 1.4 THE VAN DER WAALS EQUATION 19 Table 1.7 Selected equations of state Critical constants Equation Reduced form* pc Vc Tc Perfect gas van der Waals 3b Berthelot 3b Dieterici 2b Virial * Reduced variables are defined in Section 1.5. p RT V B T V C T V ( ) ( ) = + + + ⋅ ⋅ ⋅ ⎧ ⎨ ⎩⎪ ⎫ ⎬ ⎭⎪m m m 1 2 a bR4 a b4 2 2e p T V T V/ = − − e e2 r r r r2 2 1 p RT V b a RTV/ = − − e m m 2 3 2 3 1 2 a bR ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ / 1 12 2 3 3 1 2 aR b ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ / p T V TV = − − 8 3 1 3 2 r r r r p RT V b a TV = − − m m 2 8 27 a bR a b27 2 p T V V = − − 8 3 1 3 2 r r r p RT V b a V = − − m m 2 p RT V = m Although closed expressions for the roots of a cubic equation can be given, they are very complicated. Unless analytical solutions are essential, it is usually more expedient to solve such equations with commercial software. Answer According to Table 1.6, a = 3.592 dm6 atm mol−2 and b = 4.267 × 10−2 dm3 mol−1 . Under the stated conditions, RT/p = 0.410 dm3 mol−1 . The coefficients in the equation for Vm are therefore b + RT/p = 0.453 dm3 mol−1 a/p = 3.61 × 10−2 (dm3 mol−1 )2 ab/p = 1.55 × 10−3 (dm3 mol−1 )3 Therefore, on writing x = Vm/(dm3 mol−1 ), the equation to solve is x3 − 0.453x2 + (3.61 × 10−2 )x − (1.55 × 10−3 ) = 0 The acceptable root is x = 0.366, which implies that Vm = 0.366 dm3 mol−1 . For a perfect gas under these conditions, the molar volume is 0.410 dm3 mol−1 . Self-test 1.5 Calculate the molar volume of argon at 100°C and 100 atm on the assumption that it is a van der Waals gas. [0.298 dm3 mol−1 ] (a) The reliability of the equation We now examine to what extent the van der Waals equation predicts the behaviour of real gases. It is too optimistic to expect a single, simple expression to be the true equation of state of all substances, and accurate work on gases must resort to the virial equation, use tabulated values of the coefficients at various temperatures, and analyse the systems numerically. The advantage of the van der Waals equation, however, is that it is analytical (that is, expressed symbolically) and allows us to draw some general conclusions about real gases. When the equation fails we must use one of the other equations of state that have been proposed (some are listed in Table 1.7), invent a new one, or go back to the virial equation. That having been said, we can begin to judge the reliability of the equation by comparing the isotherms it predicts with the experimental isotherms in Fig. 1.15. Some 20 1 THE PROPERTIES OF GASES calculated isotherms are shown in Figs. 1.17 and 1.18. Apart from the oscillations below the critical temperature, they do resemble experimental isotherms quite well. The oscillations, the van der Waals loops, are unrealistic because they suggest that under some conditions an increase of pressure results in an increase of volume. Therefore they are replaced by horizontal lines drawn so the loops define equal areas above and below the lines: this procedure is called the Maxwell construction (3). The van der Waals coefficients, such as those in Table 1.7, are found by fitting the calculated curves to the experimental curves. (b) The features of the equation The principal features of the van der Waals equation can be summarized as follows. (1) Perfect gas isotherms are obtained at high temperatures and large molar volumes. When the temperature is high, RT may be so large that the first term in eqn 1.21b greatly exceeds the second. Furthermore, if the molar volume is large in the sense Vm >> b, then the denominator Vm − b ≈ Vm. Under these conditions, the equation reduces to p = RT/Vm, the perfect gas equation. (2) Liquids and gases coexist when cohesive and dispersing effects are in balance. The van der Waals loops occur when both terms in eqn 1.21b have similar magnitudes. The first term arises from the kinetic energy of the molecules and their repulsive interactions; the second represents the effect of the attractive interactions. (3) The critical constants are related to the van der Waals coefficients. Pressure Tem perature 1.0 1.5 0.8 Volume 1.5 1.0 0.5 0 0.1 1 10 1.5 1 0.8Reducedpressure,/ppc Reduced volume, /V Vc Fig. 1.17 The surface of possible states allowed by the van der Waals equation. Compare this surface with that shown in Fig. 1.8. Fig. 1.18 Van der Waals isotherms at several values of T/Tc. Compare these curves with those in Fig. 1.15. The van der Waals loops are normally replaced by horizontal straight lines. The critical isotherm is the isotherm for T/Tc = 1. Exploration Calculate the molar volume of chlorine gas on the basis of the van der Waals equation of state at 250 K and 150 kPa and calculate the percentage difference from the value predicted by the perfect gas equation. Equal areas 3 1.5 THE PRINCIPLE OF CORRESPONDING STATES 21 For T < Tc, the calculated isotherms oscillate, and each one passes through a minimum followed by a maximum. These extrema converge as T → Tc and coincide at T = Tc; at the critical point the curve has a flat inflexion (4). From the properties of curves, we know that an inflexion of this type occurs when both the first and second derivatives are zero. Hence, we can find the critical constants by calculating these derivatives and setting them equal to zero: at the critical point. The solutions of these two equations (and using eqn 1.21b to calculate pc from Vc and Tc) are (1.22) These relations provide an alternative route to the determination of a and b from the values of the critical constants. They can be tested by noting that the critical compression factor, Zc, is predicted to be equal to (1.23) for all gases. We see from Table 1.5 that, although Zc < , it is approximately constant (at 0.3) and the discrepancy is reasonably small. 1.5 The principle of corresponding states An important general technique in science for comparing the properties of objects is to choose a related fundamental property of the same kind and to set up a relative scale on that basis. We have seen that the critical constants are characteristic properties of gases, so it may be that a scale can be set up by using them as yardsticks. We therefore introduce the dimensionless reduced variables of a gas by dividing the actual variable by the corresponding critical constant: [1.24] If the reduced pressure of a gas is given, we can easily calculate its actual pressure by using p = prpc, and likewise for the volume and temperature. Van der Waals, who first tried this procedure, hoped that gases confined to the same reduced volume, Vr, at the same reduced temperature, Tr, would exert the same reduced pressure, pr. The hope was largely fulfilled (Fig. 1.19). The illustration shows the dependence of the compression factor on the reduced pressure for a variety of gases at various reduced temperatures. The success of the procedure is strikingly clear: compare this graph with Fig. 1.14, where similar data are plotted without using reduced variables. The observation that real gases at the same reduced volume and reduced temperature exert the same reduced pressure is called the principle of corresponding states. The principle is only an approximation. It works best for gases composed of spherical molecules; it fails, sometimes badly, when the molecules are non-spherical or polar. The van der Waals equation sheds some light on the principle. First, we express eqn 1.21b in terms of the reduced variables, which gives p p RT T V V b a V V r c r c r c r c = − − 2 2 p p p V V V T T Tr c r m c r c = = = 3 8 0 375.= Z p V RTc c c c = = 3 8 V b p a b T a Rbc c c= = =3 27 8 272 d d 2 m m m p V RT V b a V2 3 4 2 6 0 ( ) = − − = d d m m m p V RT V b a V( ) = − − + =2 3 2 0 4 22 1 THE PROPERTIES OF GASES 2.0 1.2 1.0 1.0 0.8 0.6 0.4 0.2 0 1 3 5 7 Reduced pressure, pr Compressionfactor,Z 0 2 4 6 Nitrogen Methane Propane Ethene Fig. 1.19 The compression factors of four of the gases shown in Fig. 1.14 plotted using reduced variables. The curves are labelled with the reduced temperature Tr = T/Tc. The use of reduced variables organizes the data on to single curves. Exploration Is there a set of conditions at which the compression factor of a van der Waals gas passes through a minimum? If so, how does the location and value of the minimum value of Z depend on the coefficients a and b? Then we express the critical constants in terms of a and b by using eqn 1.22: which can be reorganized into (1.25) This equation has the same form as the original, but the coefficients a and b, which differ from gas to gas, have disappeared. It follows that if the isotherms are plotted in terms of the reduced variables (as we did in fact in Fig. 1.18 without drawing attention to the fact), then the same curves are obtained whatever the gas. This is precisely the content of the principle of corresponding states, so the van der Waals equation is compatible with it. Looking for too much significance in this apparent triumph is mistaken, because other equations of state also accommodate the principle (Table 1.7). In fact, all we need are two parameters playing the roles of a and b, for then the equation can always be manipulated into reduced form. The observation that real gases obey the principle approximately amounts to saying that the effects of the attractive and repulsive interactions can each be approximated in terms of a single parameter. The importance of the principle is then not so much its theoretical interpretation but the way that it enables the properties of a range of gases to be coordinated on to a single diagram (for example, Fig. 1.19 instead of Fig. 1.14). p T V V r r r r 2 = − − 8 3 1 3 ap b aT b bV b a b V r r r r 22727 8 3 92 2( ) = − − DISCUSSION QUESTIONS 23 Further reading Articles and texts J.L. Pauley and E.H. Davis, P-V-T isotherms of real gases: Experimental versus calculated values. J. Chem. Educ. 63, 466 (1986). M. Ross, Equations of state. In Encyclopedia of applied physics (ed. G.L. Trigg), 6, 291. VCH, New York (1993). A. J. Walton, Three phases of matter. Oxford University Press (1983). R.P. Wayne, Chemistry of atmospheres, an introduction to the chemistry of atmospheres of earth, the planets, and their satellites. Oxford University Press (2000). Sources of data and information J.H. Dymond and E.B. Smith, The virial coefficients of pure gases and mixtures. Oxford University Press (1980). A.D. McNaught and A. Wilkinson, Compendium of chemical terminology. Blackwell Scientific, Oxford (1997). Discussion questions 1.1 Explain how the perfect gas equation of state arises by combination of Boyle’s law, Charles’s law, and Avogadro’s principle. 1.2 Explain the term ‘partial pressure’ and explain why Dalton’s law is a limiting law. 1.3 Explain how the compression factor varies with pressure and temperature and describe how it reveals information about intermolecular interactions in real gases. 1.4 What is the significance of the critical constants? 1.5 Describe the formulation of the van der Waals equation and suggest a rationale for one other equation of state in Table 1.7. 1.6 Explain how the van der Waals equation accounts for critical behaviour. Checklist of key ideas 1. A gas is a form of matter that fills any container it occupies. 2. An equation of state interrelates pressure, volume, temperature, and amount of substance: p = f(T,V,n). 3. The pressure is the force divided by the area to which the force is applied. The standard pressure is p7 = 1 bar (105 Pa). 4. Mechanical equilibrium is the condition of equality of pressure on either side of a movable wall. 5. Temperature is the property that indicates the direction of the flow of energy through a thermally conducting, rigid wall. 6. A diathermic boundary is a boundary that permits the passage of energy as heat. An adiabatic boundary is a boundary that prevents the passage of energy as heat. 7. Thermal equilibrium is a condition in which no change of state occurs when two objects A and B are in contact through a diathermic boundary. 8. The Zeroth Law of thermodynamics states that, if A is in thermal equilibrium with B, and B is in thermal equilibrium with C, then C is also in thermal equilibrium with A. 9. The Celsius and thermodynamic temperature scales are related by T/K = θ/°C + 273.15. 10. A perfect gas obeys the perfect gas equation, pV = nRT, exactly under all conditions. 11. Dalton’s law states that the pressure exerted by a mixture of gases is the sum of the partial pressures of the gases. 12. The partial pressure of any gas is defined as pJ = xJp, where xJ = nJ/n is its mole fraction in a mixture and p is the total pressure. 13. In real gases, molecular interactions affect the equation of state; the true equation of state is expressed in terms of virial coefficients B, C, . . . : pVm = RT(1 + B/Vm + C/V2 m + · · · ). 14. The vapour pressure is the pressure of a vapour in equilibrium with its condensed phase. 15. The critical point is the point at which the volumes at each end of the horizontal part of the isotherm have merged to a single point. The critical constants pc, Vc, and Tc are the pressure, molar volume, and temperature, respectively, at the critical point. 16. A supercritical fluid is a dense fluid phase above its critical temperature and pressure. 17. The van der Waals equation of state is an approximation to the true equation of state in which attractions are represented by a parameter a and repulsions are represented by a parameter b: p = nRT/(V − nb) − a(n/V)2 . 18. A reduced variable is the actual variable divided by the corresponding critical constant. 19. According to the principle of corresponding states, real gases at the same reduced volume and reduced temperature exert the same reduced pressure. 24 1 THE PROPERTIES OF GASES Exercises 1.1(a) (a) Could 131 g of xenon gas in a vessel of volume 1.0 dm3 exert a pressure of 20 atm at 25°C if it behaved as a perfect gas? If not, what pressure would it exert? (b) What pressure would it exert if it behaved as a van der Waals gas? 1.1(b) (a) Could 25 g of argon gas in a vessel of volume 1.5 dm3 exert a pressure of 2.0 bar at 30°C if it behaved as a perfect gas? If not, what pressure would it exert? (b) What pressure would it exert if it behaved as a van der Waals gas? 1.2(a) A perfect gas undergoes isothermal compression, which reduces its volume by 2.20 dm3 . The final pressure and volume of the gas are 5.04 bar and 4.65 dm3 , respectively. Calculate the original pressure of the gas in (a) bar, (b) atm. 1.2(b) A perfect gas undergoes isothermal compression, which reduces its volume by 1.80 dm3 . The final pressure and volume of the gas are 1.97 bar and 2.14 dm3 , respectively. Calculate the original pressure of the gas in (a) bar, (b) Torr. 1.3(a) A car tyre (i.e. an automobile tire) was inflated to a pressure of 24 lb in−2 (1.00 atm = 14.7 lb in−2 ) on a winter’s day when the temperature was –5°C. What pressure will be found, assuming no leaks have occurred and that the volume is constant, on a subsequent summer’s day when the temperature is 35°C? What complications should be taken into account in practice? 1.3(b) A sample of hydrogen gas was found to have a pressure of 125 kPa when the temperature was 23°C. What can its pressure be expected to be when the temperature is 11°C? 1.4(a) A sample of 255 mg of neon occupies 3.00 dm3 at 122 K. Use the perfect gas law to calculate the pressure of the gas. 1.4(b) A homeowner uses 4.00 × 103 m3 of natural gas in a year to heat a home. Assume that natural gas is all methane, CH4, and that methane is a perfect gas for the conditions of this problem, which are 1.00 atm and 20°C. What is the mass of gas used? 1.5(a) A diving bell has an air space of 3.0 m3 when on the deck of a boat. What is the volume of the air space when the bell has been lowered to a depth of 50 m? Take the mean density of sea water to be 1.025 g cm−3 and assume that the temperature is the same as on the surface. 1.5(b) What pressure difference must be generated across the length of a 15 cm vertical drinking straw in order to drink a water-like liquid of density 1.0 g cm−3 ? 1.6(a) A manometer consists of a U-shaped tube containing a liquid. One side is connected to the apparatus and the other is open to the atmosphere. The pressure inside the apparatus is then determined from the difference in heights of the liquid. Suppose the liquid is water, the external pressure is 770 Torr, and the open side is 10.0 cm lower than the side connected to the apparatus. What is the pressure in the apparatus? (The density of water at 25°C is 0.997 07 g cm−3 .) 1.6(b) A manometer like that described in Exercise 1.6a contained mercury in place of water. Suppose the external pressure is 760 Torr, and the open side is 10.0 cm higher than the side connected to the apparatus. What is the pressure in the apparatus? (The density of mercury at 25°C is 13.55 g cm−3 .) 1.7(a) In an attempt to determine an accurate value of the gas constant, R, a student heated a container of volume 20.000 dm3 filled with 0.251 32 g of helium gas to 500°C and measured the pressure as 206.402 cm of water in a manometer at 25°C. Calculate the value of R from these data. (The density of water at 25°C is 0.997 07 g cm−3 ; the construction of a manometer is described in Exercise 1.6a.) 1.7(b) The following data have been obtained for oxygen gas at 273.15 K. Calculate the best value of the gas constant R from them and the best value of the molar mass of O2. p/atm 0.750 000 0.500 000 0.250 000 Vm/(dm3 mol−1 ) 29.9649 44.8090 89.6384 ρ/(g dm−3 ) 1.07144 0.714110 0.356975 1.8(a) At 500°C and 93.2 kPa, the mass density of sulfur vapour is 3.710 kg m−3 . What is the molecular formula of sulfur under these conditions? 1.8(b) At 100°C and 1.60 kPa, the mass density of phosphorus vapour is 0.6388 kg m−3 . What is the molecular formula of phosphorus under these conditions? 1.9(a) Calculate the mass of water vapour present in a room of volume 400 m3 that contains air at 27°C on a day when the relative humidity is 60 per cent. 1.9(b) Calculate the mass of water vapour present in a room of volume 250 m3 that contains air at 23°C on a day when the relative humidity is 53 per cent. 1.10(a) Given that the density of air at 0.987 bar and 27°C is 1.146 kg m−3 , calculate the mole fraction and partial pressure of nitrogen and oxygen assuming that (a) air consists only of these two gases, (b) air also contains 1.0 mole per cent Ar. 1.10(b) A gas mixture consists of 320 mg of methane, 175 mg of argon, and 225 mg of neon. The partial pressure of neon at 300 K is 8.87 kPa. Calculate (a) the volume and (b) the total pressure of the mixture. 1.11(a) The density of a gaseous compound was found to be 1.23 kg m−3 at 330 K and 20 kPa. What is the molar mass of the compound? 1.11(b) In an experiment to measure the molar mass of a gas, 250 cm3 of the gas was confined in a glass vessel. The pressure was 152 Torr at 298 K and, after correcting for buoyancy effects, the mass of the gas was 33.5 mg. What is the molar mass of the gas? 1.12(a) The densities of air at −85°C, 0°C, and 100°C are 1.877 g dm−3 , 1.294 g dm−3 , and 0.946 g dm−3 , respectively. From these data, and assuming that air obeys Charles’s law, determine a value for the absolute zero of temperature in degrees Celsius. 1.12(b) A certain sample of a gas has a volume of 20.00 dm3 at 0°C and 1.000 atm. A plot of the experimental data of its volume against the Celsius temperature, θ, at constant p, gives a straight line of slope 0.0741 dm3 (°C)−1 . From these data alone (without making use of the perfect gas law), determine the absolute zero of temperature in degrees Celsius. 1.13(a) Calculate the pressure exerted by 1.0 mol C2H6 behaving as (a) a perfect gas, (b) a van der Waals gas when it is confined under the following conditions: (i) at 273.15 K in 22.414 dm3 , (ii) at 1000 K in 100 cm3 . Use the data in Table 1.6. 1.13(b) Calculate the pressure exerted by 1.0 mol H2S behaving as (a) a perfect gas, (b) a van der Waals gas when it is confined under the following conditions: (i) at 273.15 K in 22.414 dm3 , (ii) at 500 K in 150 cm3 . Use the data in Table 1.6. 1.14(a) Express the van der Waals parameters a = 0.751 atm dm6 mol−2 and b = 0.0226 dm3 mol−1 in SI base units. 1.14(b) Express the van der Waals parameters a = 1.32 atm dm6 mol−2 and b = 0.0436 dm3 mol−1 in SI base units. 1.15(a) A gas at 250 K and 15 atm has a molar volume 12 per cent smaller than that calculated from the perfect gas law. Calculate (a) the compression factor under these conditions and (b) the molar volume of the gas. Which are dominating in the sample, the attractive or the repulsive forces? PROBLEMS 25 1.15(b) A gas at 350 K and 12 atm has a molar volume 12 per cent larger than that calculated from the perfect gas law. Calculate (a) the compression factor under these conditions and (b) the molar volume of the gas. Which are dominating in the sample, the attractive or the repulsive forces? 1.16(a) In an industrial process, nitrogen is heated to 500 K at a constant volume of 1.000 m3 . The gas enters the container at 300 K and 100 atm. The mass of the gas is 92.4 kg. Use the van der Waals equation to determine the approximate pressure of the gas at its working temperature of 500 K. For nitrogen, a = 1.352 dm6 atm mol−2 , b = 0.0387 dm3 mol−1 . 1.16(b) Cylinders of compressed gas are typically filled to a pressure of 200 bar. For oxygen, what would be the molar volume at this pressure and 25°C based on (a) the perfect gas equation, (b) the van der Waals equation. For oxygen, a = 1.364 dm6 atm mol−2 , b = 3.19 × 10−2 dm3 mol−1 . 1.17(a) Suppose that 10.0 mol C2H6(g) is confined to 4.860 dm3 at 27°C. Predict the pressure exerted by the ethane from (a) the perfect gas and (b) the van der Waals equations of state. Calculate the compression factor based on these calculations. For ethane, a = 5.507 dm6 atm mol−2 , b = 0.0651 dm3 mol−1 . 1.17(b) At 300 K and 20 atm, the compression factor of a gas is 0.86. Calculate (a) the volume occupied by 8.2 mmol of the gas under these conditions and (b) an approximate value of the second virial coefficient B at 300 K. 1.18(a) A vessel of volume 22.4 dm3 contains 2.0 mol H2 and 1.0 mol N2 at 273.15 K. Calculate (a) the mole fractions of each component, (b) their partial pressures, and (c) their total pressure. 1.18(b) A vessel of volume 22.4 dm3 contains 1.5 mol H2 and 2.5 mol N2 at 273.15 K. Calculate (a) the mole fractions of each component, (b) their partial pressures, and (c) their total pressure. 1.19(a) The critical constants of methane are pc = 45.6 atm, Vc = 98.7 cm3 mol−1 , and Tc = 190.6 K. Calculate the van der Waals parameters of the gas and estimate the radius of the molecules. 1.19(b) The critical constants of ethane are pc = 48.20 atm, Vc = 148 cm3 mol−1 , and Tc = 305.4 K. Calculate the van der Waals parameters of the gas and estimate the radius of the molecules. 1.20(a) Use the van der Waals parameters for chlorine to calculate approximate values of (a) the Boyle temperature of chlorine and (b) the radius of a Cl2 molecule regarded as a sphere. 1.20(b) Use the van der Waals parameters for hydrogen sulfide to calculate approximate values of (a) the Boyle temperature of the gas and (b) the radius of a H2S molecule regarded as a sphere (a = 4.484 dm6 atm mol−2 , b = 0.0434 dm3 mol−1 ). 1.21(a) Suggest the pressure and temperature at which 1.0 mol of (a) NH3, (b) Xe, (c) He will be in states that correspond to 1.0 mol H2 at 1.0 atm and 25°C. 1.21(b) Suggest the pressure and temperature at which 1.0 mol of (a) H2S, (b) CO2, (c) Ar will be in states that correspond to 1.0 mol N2 at 1.0 atm and 25°C. 1.22(a) A certain gas obeys the van der Waals equation with a = 0.50 m6 Pa mol−2 . Its volume is found to be 5.00 × 10−4 m3 mol−1 at 273 K and 3.0 MPa. From this information calculate the van der Waals constant b. What is the compression factor for this gas at the prevailing temperature and pressure? 1.22(b) A certain gas obeys the van der Waals equation with a = 0.76 m6 Pa mol−2 . Its volume is found to be 4.00 × 10−4 m3 mol−1 at 288 K and 4.0 MPa. From this information calculate the van der Waals constant b. What is the compression factor for this gas at the prevailing temperature and pressure? Problems* Numerical problems 1.1 Recent communication with the inhabitants of Neptune have revealed that they have a Celsius-type temperature scale, but based on the melting point (0°N) and boiling point (100°N) of their most common substance, hydrogen. Further communications have revealed that the Neptunians know about perfect gas behaviour and they find that, in the limit of zero pressure, the value of pV is 28 dm3 atm at 0°N and 40 dm3 atm at 100°N. What is the value of the absolute zero of temperature on their temperature scale? 1.2 Deduce the relation between the pressure and mass density, ρ, of a perfect gas of molar mass M. Confirm graphically, using the following data on dimethyl ether at 25°C, that perfect behaviour is reached at low pressures and find the molar mass of the gas. p/kPa 12.223 25.20 36.97 60.37 85.23 101.3 ρ/(kg m−3 ) 0.225 0.456 0.664 1.062 1.468 1.734 1.3 Charles’s law is sometimes expressed in the form V = V0(1 + αθ), where θ is the Celsius temperature, α is a constant, and V0 is the volume of the sample at 0°C. The following values for α have been reported for nitrogen at 0°C: p/Torr 749.7 599.6 333.1 98.6 103 α/(°C)−1 3.6717 3.6697 3.6665 3.6643 For these data calculate the best value for the absolute zero of temperature on the Celsius scale. 1.4 The molar mass of a newly synthesized fluorocarbon was measured in a gas microbalance. This device consists of a glass bulb forming one end of a beam, the whole surrounded by a closed container. The beam is pivoted, and the balance point is attained by raising the pressure of gas in the container, so increasing the buoyancy of the enclosed bulb. In one experiment, the balance point was reached when the fluorocarbon pressure was 327.10 Torr; for the same setting of the pivot, a balance was reached when CHF3 (M = 70.014 g mol−1 ) was introduced at 423.22 Torr. A repeat of the experiment with a different setting of the pivot required a pressure of 293.22 Torr of the fluorocarbon and 427.22 Torr of the CHF3. What is the molar mass of the fluorocarbon? Suggest a molecular formula. 1.5 A constant-volume perfect gas thermometer indicates a pressure of 6.69 kPa at the triple point temperature of water (273.16 K). (a) What change of pressure indicates a change of 1.00 K at this temperature? (b) What pressure indicates a temperature of 100.00°C? (c) What change of pressure indicates a change of 1.00 K at the latter temperature? 1.6 A vessel of volume 22.4 dm3 contains 2.0 mol H2 and 1.0 mol N2 at 273.15 K initially. All the H2 reacted with sufficient N2 to form NH3. Calculate the partial pressures and the total pressure of the final mixture. 1.7 Calculate the molar volume of chlorine gas at 350 K and 2.30 atm using (a) the perfect gas law and (b) the van der Waals equation. Use the answer to (a) to calculate a first approximation to the correction term for attraction and then use successive approximations to obtain a numerical answer for part (b). * Problems denoted with the symbol ‡ were supplied by Charles Trapp, Carmen Giunta, and Marshall Cady. 26 1 THE PROPERTIES OF GASES 1.8 At 273 K measurements on argon gave B = −21.7 cm3 mol−1 and C = 1200 cm6 mol−2 , where B and C are the second and third virial coefficients in the expansion of Z in powers of 1/Vm. Assuming that the perfect gas law holds sufficiently well for the estimation of the second and third terms of the expansion, calculate the compression factor of argon at 100 atm and 273 K. From your result, estimate the molar volume of argon under these conditions. 1.9 Calculate the volume occupied by 1.00 mol N2 using the van der Waals equation in the form of a virial expansion at (a) its critical temperature, (b) its Boyle temperature, and (c) its inversion temperature. Assume that the pressure is 10 atm throughout. At what temperature is the gas most perfect? Use the following data: Tc = 126.3 K, a = 1.352 dm6 atm mol−2 , b = 0.0387 dm3 mol−1 . 1.10‡ The second virial coefficient of methane can be approximated by the empirical equation B′(T) = a + be−c/T2 , where a = −0.1993 bar−1 , b = 0.2002 bar−1 , and c = 1131 K2 with 300 K < T < 600 K. What is the Boyle temperature of methane? 1.11 The mass density of water vapour at 327.6 atm and 776.4 K is 133.2 kg m−3 . Given that for water Tc = 647.4 K, pc = 218.3 atm, a = 5.464 dm6 atm mol−2 , b = 0.03049 dm3 mol−1 , and M = 18.02 g mol−1 , calculate (a) the molar volume. Then calculate the compression factor (b) from the data, (c) from the virial expansion of the van der Waals equation. 1.12 The critical volume and critical pressure of a certain gas are 160 cm3 mol−1 and 40 atm, respectively. Estimate the critical temperature by assuming that the gas obeys the Berthelot equation of state. Estimate the radii of the gas molecules on the assumption that they are spheres. 1.13 Estimate the coefficients a and b in the Dieterici equation of state from the critical constants of xenon. Calculate the pressure exerted by 1.0 mol Xe when it is confined to 1.0 dm3 at 25°C. Theoretical problems 1.14 Show that the van der Waals equation leads to values of Z < 1 and Z > 1, and identify the conditions for which these values are obtained. 1.15 Express the van der Waals equation of state as a virial expansion in powers of 1/Vm and obtain expressions for B and C in terms of the parameters a and b. The expansion you will need is (1 − x)−1 = 1 + x + x2 + · · · . Measurements on argon gave B = −21.7 cm3 mol−1 and C = 1200 cm6 mol−2 for the virial coefficients at 273 K. What are the values of a and b in the corresponding van der Waals equation of state? 1.16‡ Derive the relation between the critical constants and the Dieterici equation parameters. Show that Zc = 2e−2 and derive the reduced form of the Dieterici equation of state. Compare the van der Waals and Dieterici predictions of the critical compression factor. Which is closer to typical experimental values? 1.17 A scientist proposed the following equation of state: p = − + Show that the equation leads to critical behaviour. Find the critical constants of the gas in terms of B and C and an expression for the critical compression factor. 1.18 Equations 1.18 and 1.19 are expansions in p and 1/Vm, respectively. Find the relation between B, C and B′, C′. 1.19 The second virial coefficient B′ can be obtained from measurements of the density ρ of a gas at a series of pressures. Show that the graph of p/ρ against p should be a straight line with slope proportional to B′. Use the data on dimethyl ether in Problem 1.2 to find the values of B′ and B at 25°C. C V3 m B V2 m RT Vm 1.20 The equation of state of a certain gas is given by p = RT/Vm + (a + bT)/V2 m, where a and b are constants. Find (∂V/∂T)p. 1.21 The following equations of state are occasionally used for approximate calculations on gases: (gas A) pVm = RT(1 + b/Vm), (gas B) p(Vm – b) = RT. Assuming that there were gases that actually obeyed these equations of state, would it be possible to liquefy either gas A or B? Would they have a critical temperature? Explain your answer. 1.22 Derive an expression for the compression factor of a gas that obeys the equation of state p(V – nb) = nRT, where b and R are constants. If the pressure and temperature are such that Vm = 10b, what is the numerical value of the compression factor? 1.23‡ The discovery of the element argon by Lord Rayleigh and Sir William Ramsay had its origins in Rayleigh’s measurements of the density of nitrogen with an eye toward accurate determination of its molar mass. Rayleigh prepared some samples of nitrogen by chemical reaction of nitrogencontaining compounds; under his standard conditions, a glass globe filled with this ‘chemical nitrogen’ had a mass of 2.2990 g. He prepared other samples by removing oxygen, carbon dioxide, and water vapour from atmospheric air; under the same conditions, this ‘atmospheric nitrogen’ had a mass of 2.3102 g (Lord Rayleigh, Royal Institution Proceedings 14, 524 (1895)). With the hindsight of knowing accurate values for the molar masses of nitrogen and argon, compute the mole fraction of argon in the latter sample on the assumption that the former was pure nitrogen and the latter a mixture of nitrogen and argon. 1.24‡ A substance as elementary and well known as argon still receives research attention. Stewart and Jacobsen have published a review of thermodynamic properties of argon (R.B. Stewart and R.T. Jacobsen, J. Phys. Chem. Ref. Data 18, 639 (1989)) that included the following 300 K isotherm. p/MPa 0.4000 0.5000 0.6000 0.8000 1.000 Vm/(dm3 mol−1 ) 6.2208 4.9736 4.1423 3.1031 2.4795 p/MPa 1.500 2.000 2.500 3.000 4.000 Vm/(dm3 mol−1 ) 1.6483 1.2328 0.98357 0.81746 0.60998 (a) Compute the second virial coefficient, B, at this temperature. (b) Use non-linear curve-fitting software to compute the third virial coefficient, C, at this temperature. Applications: to environmental science 1.25 Atmospheric pollution is a problem that has received much attention. Not all pollution, however, is from industrial sources. Volcanic eruptions can be a significant source of air pollution. The Kilauea volcano in Hawaii emits 200–300 t of SO2 per day. If this gas is emitted at 800°C and 1.0 atm, what volume of gas is emitted? 1.26 Ozone is a trace atmospheric gas that plays an important role in screening the Earth from harmful ultraviolet radiation, and the abundance of ozone is commonly reported in Dobson units. One Dobson unit is the thickness, in thousandths of a centimetre, of a column of gas if it were collected as a pure gas at 1.00 atm and 0°C. What amount of O3 (in moles) is found in a column of atmosphere with a cross-sectional area of 1.00 dm2 if the abundance is 250 Dobson units (a typical mid-latitude value)? In the seasonal Antarctic ozone hole, the column abundance drops below 100 Dobson units; how many moles of ozone are found in such a column of air above a 1.00 dm2 area? Most atmospheric ozone is found between 10 and 50 km above the surface of the earth. If that ozone is spread uniformly through this portion of the atmosphere, what is the average molar concentration corresponding to (a) 250 Dobson units, (b) 100 Dobson units? 1.27 The barometric formula relates the pressure of a gas of molar mass M at an altitude h to its pressure p0 at sea level. Derive this relation by showing that PROBLEMS 27 the change in pressure dp for an infinitesimal change in altitude dh where the density is ρ is dp = −ρgdh. Remember that ρ depends on the pressure. Evaluate (a) the pressure difference between the top and bottom of a laboratory vessel of height 15 cm, and (b) the external atmospheric pressure at a typical cruising altitude of an aircraft (11 km) when the pressure at ground level is 1.0 atm. 1.28 Balloons are still used to deploy sensors that monitor meteorological phenomena and the chemistry of the atmosphere. It is possible to investigate some of the technicalities of ballooning by using the perfect gas law. Suppose your balloon has a radius of 3.0 m and that it is spherical. (a) What amount of H2 (in moles) is needed to inflate it to 1.0 atm in an ambient temperature of 25°C at sea level? (b) What mass can the balloon lift at sea level, where the density of air is 1.22 kg m−3 ? (c) What would be the payload if He were used instead of H2? 1.29‡ The preceding problem is most readily solved (see the Solutions manual) with the use of the Archimedes principle, which states that the lifting force is equal to the difference between the weight of the displaced air and the weight of the balloon. Prove the Archimedes principle for the atmosphere from the barometric formula. Hint. Assume a simple shape for the balloon, perhaps a right circular cylinder of cross–sectional area A and height h. 1.30 ‡ Chlorofluorocarbons such as CCl3F and CCl2F2 have been linked to ozone depletion in Antarctica. As of 1994, these gases were found in quantities of 261 and 509 parts per trillion (1012 ) by volume (World Resources Institute, World resources 1996–97). Compute the molar concentration of these gases under conditions typical of (a) the mid-latitude troposphere (10°C and 1.0 atm) and (b) the Antarctic stratosphere (200 K and 0.050 atm). The First Law This chapter introduces some of the basic concepts of thermodynamics. It concentrates on the conservation of energy—the experimental observation that energy can be neither created nor destroyed—and shows how the principle of the conservation of energy can be used to assess the energy changes that accompany physical and chemical processes. Much of this chapter examines the means by which a system can exchange energy with its surroundings in terms of the work it may do or the heat that it may produce. The target concept of the chapter is enthalpy, which is a very useful book-keeping property for keeping track of the heat output (or requirements) of physical processes and chemical reactions at constant pressure. We also begin to unfold some of the power of thermodynamics by showing how to establish relations between different properties of a system. We shall see that one very useful aspect of thermodynamics is that a property can be measured indirectly by measuring others and then combining their values. The relations we derive also enable us to discuss the liquefaction of gases and to establish the relation between the heat capacities of a substance under different conditions. The release of energy can be used to provide heat when a fuel burns in a furnace, to produce mechanical work when a fuel burns in an engine, and to generate electrical work when a chemical reaction pumps electrons through a circuit. In chemistry, we encounter reactions that can be harnessed to provide heat and work, reactions that liberate energy which is squandered (often to the detriment of the environment) but which give products we require, and reactions that constitute the processes of life. Thermodynamics, the study of the transformations of energy, enables us to discuss all these matters quantitatively and to make useful predictions. The basic concepts For the purposes of physical chemistry, the universe is divided into two parts, the system and its surroundings. The system is the part of the world in which we have a special interest. It may be a reaction vessel, an engine, an electrochemical cell, a biological cell, and so on. The surroundings comprise the region outside the system and are where we make our measurements. The type of system depends on the characteristics of the boundary that divides it from the surroundings (Fig. 2.1). If matter can be transferred through the boundary between the system and its surroundings the system is classified as open. If matter cannot pass through the boundary the system is classified as closed. Both open and closed systems can exchange energy with their surroundings. For example, a closed system can expand and thereby raise a weight in the surroundings; it may also transfer energy to them if they are at a lower temperature. The basic concepts 2.1 Work, heat, and energy 2.2 The internal energy 2.3 Expansion work 2.4 Heat transactions 2.5 Enthalpy I2.1 Impact on biochemistry and materials science: Differential scanning calorimetry 2.6 Adiabatic changes Thermochemistry 2.7 Standard enthalpy changes I2.2 Impact on biology: Food and energy reserves 2.8 Standard enthalpies of formation 2.9 The temperature-dependence of reaction enthalpies State functions and exact differentials 2.10 Exact and inexact differentials 2.11 Changes in internal energy 2.12 The Joule–Thomson effect Checklist of key ideas Further reading Further information 2.1: Adiabatic processes Further information 2.2: The relation between heat capacities Discussion questions Exercises Problems 2 2.1 WORK, HEAT, AND ENERGY 29 Fig. 2.1 (a) An open system can exchange matter and energy with its surroundings. (b) A closed system can exchange energy with its surroundings, but it cannot exchange matter. (c) An isolated system can exchange neither energy nor matter with its surroundings. An isolated systemis a closed system that has neither mechanical nor thermal contact with its surroundings. 2.1 Work, heat, and energy The fundamental physical property in thermodynamics is work: work is motion against an opposing force. Doing work is equivalent to raising a weight somewhere in the surroundings. An example of doing work is the expansion of a gas that pushes out a piston and raises a weight. A chemical reaction that drives an electric current through a resistance also does work, because the same current could be driven through a motor and used to raise a weight. The energy of a system is its capacity to do work. When work is done on an otherwise isolated system (for instance, by compressing a gas or winding a spring), the capacity of the system to do work is increased; in other words, the energy of the system is increased. When the system does work (when the piston moves out or the spring unwinds), the energy of the system is reduced and it can do less work than before. Experiments have shown that the energy of a system may be changed by means other than work itself. When the energy of a system changes as a result of a temperature difference between the system and its surroundings we say that energy has been transferred as heat. When a heater is immersed in a beaker of water (the system), the capacity of the system to do work increases because hot water can be used to do more work than the same amount of cold water. Not all boundaries permit the transfer of energy even though there is a temperature difference between the system and its surroundings. An exothermic process is a process that releases energy as heat into its surroundings. All combustion reactions are exothermic. An endothermic process is a process in which energy is acquired from its surroundings as heat. An example of an endothermic process is the vaporization of water. To avoid a lot of awkward circumlocution, we say that in an exothermic process energy is transferred ‘as heat’ to the surroundings and in an endothermic process energy is transferred ‘as heat’ from the surroundings into the system. However, it must never be forgotten that heat is a process (the transfer of energy as a result of a temperature difference), not an entity. An endothermic process in a diathermic container results in energy flowing into the system as heat. An exothermic process in a similar diathermic container results in a release of energy as heat into the surroundings. When an endothermic process takes place in an adiabatic container, it results in a lowering of temperature of the system; an exothermic process results in a rise of temperature. These features are summarized in Fig. 2.2. Molecular interpretation 2.1 Heat and work In molecular terms, heating is the transfer of energy that makes use of disorderly molecular motion. The disorderly motion of molecules is called thermal motion. The thermal motion of the molecules in the hot surroundings stimulates the molecules in the cooler system to move more vigorously and, as a result, the energy of the system is increased. When a system heats its surroundings, molecules of the system stimulate the thermal motion of the molecules in the surroundings (Fig. 2.3). In contrast, work is the transfer of energy that makes use of organized motion (Fig. 2.4). When a weight is raised or lowered, its atoms move in an organized way (up or down). The atoms in a spring move in an orderly way when it is wound; the 30 2 THE FIRST LAW Fig. 2.2 (a) When an endothermic process occurs in an adiabatic system, the temperature falls; (b) if the process is exothermic, then the temperature rises. (c) When an endothermic process occurs in a diathermic container, energy enters as heat from the surroundings, and the system remains at the same temperature. (d) If the process is exothermic, then energy leaves as heat, and the process is isothermal. 1 The internal energy does not include the kinetic energy arising from the motion of the system as a whole, such as its kinetic energy as it accompanies the Earth on its orbit round the Sun. Fig. 2.3 When energy is transferred to the surroundings as heat, the transfer stimulates random motion of the atoms in the surroundings. Transfer of energy from the surroundings to the system makes use of random motion (thermal motion) in the surroundings. Fig. 2.4 When a system does work, it stimulates orderly motion in the surroundings. For instance, the atoms shown here may be part of a weight that is being raised. The ordered motion of the atoms in a falling weight does work on the system. electrons in an electric current move in an orderly direction when it flows. When a system does work it causes atoms or electrons in its surroundings to move in an organized way. Likewise, when work is done on a system, molecules in the surroundings are used to transfer energy to it in an organized way, as the atoms in a weight are lowered or a current of electrons is passed. The distinction between work and heat is made in the surroundings. The fact that a falling weight may stimulate thermal motion in the system is irrelevant to the distinction between heat and work: work is identified as energy transfer making use of the organized motion of atoms in the surroundings, and heat is identified as energy transfer making use of thermal motion in the surroundings. In the compression of a gas, for instance, work is done as the atoms of the compressing weight descend in an orderly way, but the effect of the incoming piston is to accelerate the gas molecules to higher average speeds. Because collisions between molecules quickly randomize their directions, the orderly motion of the atoms of the weight is in effect stimulating thermal motion in the gas. We observe the falling weight, the orderly descent of its atoms, and report that work is being done even though it is stimulating thermal motion. 2.2 The internal energy In thermodynamics, the total energy of a system is called its internal energy, U. The internal energy is the total kinetic and potential energy of the molecules in the system (see Comment 1.3 for the definitions of kinetic and potential energy).1 We denote by ∆U the change in internal energy when a system changes from an initial state i with internal energy Ui to a final state f of internal energy Uf: ∆U = Uf − Ui [2.1] 2.2 THE INTERNAL ENERGY 31 Comment 2.1 An extensive property is a property that depends on the amount of substance in the sample. An intensive property is a property that is independent of the amount of substance in the sample. Two examples of extensive properties are mass and volume. Examples of intensive properties are temperature, mass density (mass divided by volume), and pressure. The internal energy is a state function in the sense that its value depends only on the current state of the system and is independent of how that state has been prepared. In other words, it is a function of the properties that determine the current state of the system. Changing any one of the state variables, such as the pressure, results in a change in internal energy. The internal energy is an extensive property. That the internal energy is a state function has consequences of the greatest importance, as we start to unfold in Section 2.10. Internal energy, heat, and work are all measured in the same units, the joule (J). The joule, which is named after the nineteenth-century scientist J.P. Joule, is defined as 1 J = 1 kg m2 s−2 A joule is quite a small unit of energy: for instance, each beat of the human heart consumes about 1 J. Changes in molar internal energy, ∆Um, are typically expressed in kilojoules per mole (kJ mol−1 ). Certain other energy units are also used, but are more common in fields other than thermodynamics. Thus, 1 electronvolt (1 eV) is defined as the kinetic energy acquired when an electron is accelerated from rest through a potential difference of 1 V; the relation between electronvolts and joules is 1 eV ≈ 0.16 aJ (where 1 aJ = 10−18 J). Many processes in chemistry have an energy of several electronvolts. Thus, the energy to remove an electron from a sodium atom is close to 5 eV. Calories (cal) and kilocalories (kcal) are still encountered. The current definition of the calorie in terms of joules is 1 cal = 4.184 J exactly An energy of 1 cal is enough to raise the temperature of 1 g of water by 1°C. Molecular interpretation 2.2 The internal energy of a gas A molecule has a certain number of degrees of freedom, such as the ability to translate (the motion of its centre of mass through space), rotate around its centre of mass, or vibrate (as its bond lengths and angles change). Many physical and chemical properties depend on the energy associated with each of these modes of motion. For example, a chemical bond might break if a lot of energy becomes concentrated in it. The equipartition theorem of classical mechanics is a useful guide to the average energy associated with each degree of freedom when the sample is at a temperature T. First, we need to know that a ‘quadratic contribution’ to the energy means a contribution that can be expressed as the square of a variable, such as the position or the velocity. For example, the kinetic energy an atom of mass m as it moves through space is EK = 1 –2mvx 2 + 1 –2mvy 2 + 1 –2mvz 2 and there are three quadratic contributions to its energy. The equipartition theorem then states that, for a collection of particles at thermal equilibrium at a temperature T, the average value of each quadratic contribution to the energy is the same and equal to 1 –2kT, where k is Boltzmann’s constant (k = 1.381 × 10−23 J K−1 ). The equipartition theorem is a conclusion from classical mechanics and is applicable only when the effects of quantization can be ignored (see Chapters 16 and 17). In practice, it can be used for molecular translation and rotation but not vibration. At 25°C, 1 –2kT = 2 zJ (where 1 zJ = 10−21 J), or about 13 meV. According to the equipartition theorem, the average energy of each term in the expression above is 1 –2kT. Therefore, the mean energy of the atoms is 3 –2kT and the 32 2 THE FIRST LAW Fig. 2.5 The rotational modes of molecules and the corresponding average energies at a temperature T. (a) A linear molecule can rotate about two axes perpendicular to the line of the atoms. (b) A nonlinear molecule can rotate about three perpendicular axes. total energy of the gas (there being no potential energy contribution) is 3 –2NkT, or 3 –2nRT (because N = nNA and R = NAk). We can therefore write Um = Um(0) + 3 –2RT where Um(0) is the molar internal energy at T = 0, when all translational motion has ceased and the sole contribution to the internal energy arises from the internal structure of the atoms. This equation shows that the internal energy of a perfect gas increases linearly with temperature. At 25°C, 3 –2RT = 3.7 kJ mol−1 , so translational motion contributes about 4 kJ mol−1 to the molar internal energy of a gaseous sample of atoms or molecules (the remaining contribution arises from the internal structure of the atoms and molecules). When the gas consists of polyatomic molecules, we need to take into account the effect of rotation and vibration. A linear molecule, such as N2 and CO2, can rotate around two axes perpendicular to the line of the atoms (Fig. 2.5), so it has two rotational modes of motion, each contributing a term 1 –2kT to the internal energy. Therefore, the mean rotational energy is kT and the rotational contribution to the molar internal energy is RT. By adding the translational and rotational contributions, we obtain Um = Um(0) + 5–2RT (linear molecule, translation and rotation only) A nonlinear molecule, such as CH4 or water, can rotate around three axes and, again, each mode of motion contributes a term 1–2kT to the internal energy. Therefore, the mean rotational energy is 3 –2kT and there is a rotational contribution of 3 –2RT to the molar internal energy of the molecule. That is, Um = Um(0) + 3RT (nonlinear molecule, translation and rotation only) The internal energy now increases twice as rapidly with temperature compared with the monatomic gas. The internal energy of interacting molecules in condensed phases also has a contribution from the potential energy of their interaction. However, no simple expressions can be written down in general. Nevertheless, the crucial molecular point is that, as the temperature of a system is raised, the internal energy increases as the various modes of motion become more highly excited. It has been found experimentally that the internal energy of a system may be changed either by doing work on the system or by heating it. Whereas we may know how the energy transfer has occurred (because we can see if a weight has been raised or lowered in the surroundings, indicating transfer of energy by doing work, or if ice has melted in the surroundings, indicating transfer of energy as heat), the system is blind to the mode employed. Heat and work are equivalent ways of changing a system’s internal energy. A system is like a bank: it accepts deposits in either currency, but stores its reserves as internal energy. It is also found experimentally that, if a system is isolated from its surroundings, then no change in internal energy takes place. This summary of observations is now known as the First Law of thermodynamics and expressed as follows: The internal energy of an isolated system is constant. We cannot use a system to do work, leave it isolated for a month, and then come back expecting to find it restored to its original state and ready to do the same work again. The evidence for this property is that no ‘perpetual motion machine’ (a machine that 2.3 EXPANSION WORK 33 does work without consuming fuel or some other source of energy) has ever been built. These remarks may be summarized as follows. If we write w for the work done on a system, q for the energy transferred as heat to a system, and ∆U for the resulting change in internal energy, then it follows that ∆U = q + w (2.2) Equation 2.2 is the mathematical statement of the First Law, for it summarizes the equivalence of heat and work and the fact that the internal energy is constant in an isolated system (for which q = 0 and w = 0). The equation states that the change in internal energy of a closed system is equal to the energy that passes through its boundary as heat or work. It employs the ‘acquisitive convention’, in which w > 0 or q > 0 if energy is transferred to the system as work or heat and w < 0 or q < 0 if energy is lost from the system as work or heat. In other words, we view the flow of energy as work or heat from the system’s perspective. Illustration 2.1 The sign convention in thermodynamics If an electric motor produced 15 kJ of energy each second as mechanical work and lost 2 kJ as heat to the surroundings, then the change in the internal energy of the motor each second is ∆U = −2 kJ − 15 kJ = −17 kJ Suppose that, when a spring was wound, 100 J of work was done on it but 15 J escaped to the surroundings as heat. The change in internal energy of the spring is ∆U = +100 kJ − 15 kJ = +85 kJ 2.3 Expansion work The way can now be opened to powerful methods of calculation by switching attention to infinitesimal changes of state (such as infinitesimal change in temperature) and infinitesimal changes in the internal energy dU. Then, if the work done on a system is dw and the energy supplied to it as heat is dq, in place of eqn 2.2 we have dU = dq + dw (2.3) To use this expression we must be able to relate dq and dw to events taking place in the surroundings. We begin by discussing expansion work, the work arising from a change in volume. This type of work includes the work done by a gas as it expands and drives back the atmosphere. Many chemical reactions result in the generation or consumption of gases (for instance, the thermal decomposition of calcium carbonate or the combustion of octane), and the thermodynamic characteristics of a reaction depend on the work it can do. The term ‘expansion work’ also includes work associated with negative changes of volume, that is, compression. (a) The general expression for work The calculation of expansion work starts from the definition used in physics, which states that the work required to move an object a distance dz against an opposing force of magnitude F is dw = −Fdz [2.4] 34 2 THE FIRST LAW The negative sign tells us that, when the system moves an object against an opposing force, the internal energy of the system doing the work will decrease. Now consider the arrangement shown in Fig. 2.6, in which one wall of a system is a massless, frictionless, rigid, perfectly fitting piston of area A. If the external pressure is pex, the magnitude of the force acting on the outer face of the piston is F = pexA. When the system expands through a distance dz against an external pressure pex, it follows that the work done is dw = −pexAdz. But Adz is the change in volume, dV, in the course of the expansion. Therefore, the work done when the system expands by dV against a pressure pex is dw = −pexdV (2.5) To obtain the total work done when the volume changes from Vi to Vf we integrate this expression between the initial and final volumes: w = − Ύ Vf Vi pexdV (2.6) The force acting on the piston, pexA, is equivalent to a weight that is raised as the system expands. If the system is compressed instead, then the same weight is lowered in the surroundings and eqn 2.6 can still be used, but now Vf < Vi. It is important to note that it is still the external pressure that determines the magnitude of the work. This somewhat perplexing conclusion seems to be inconsistent with the fact that the gas inside the container is opposing the compression. However, when a gas is compressed, the ability of the surroundings to do work is diminished by an amount determined by the weight that is lowered, and it is this energy that is transferred into the system. Other types of work (for example, electrical work), which we shall call either nonexpansion work or additional work, have analogous expressions, with each one the product of an intensive factor (the pressure, for instance) and an extensive factor (the change in volume). Some are collected in Table 2.1. For the present we continue with the work associated with changing the volume, the expansion work, and see what we can extract from eqns 2.5 and 2.6. (b) Free expansion By free expansion we mean expansion against zero opposing force. It occurs when pex = 0. According to eqn 2.5, dw = 0 for each stage of the expansion. Hence, overall: Free expansion: w = 0 (2.7) Fig. 2.6 When a piston of area A moves out through a distance dz, it sweeps out a volume dV = Adz. The external pressure pex is equivalent to a weight pressing on the piston, and the force opposing expansion is F = pexA. Table 2.1 Varieties of work* Type of work dw Comments Units† Expansion −pexdV pex is the external pressure Pa dV is the change in volume m3 Surface expansion γdσ γ is the surface tension N m−1 dσ is the change in area m2 Extension fdl f is the tension N dl is the change in length m Electrical φdQ φ is the electric potential V dQ is the change in charge C * In general, the work done on a system can be expressed in the form dw = −Fdz, where F is a ‘generalized force’ and dz is a ‘generalized displacement’. † For work in joules (J). Note that 1 N m = 1 J and 1 V C = 1 J. 2.3 EXPANSION WORK 35 That is, no work is done when a system expands freely. Expansion of this kind occurs when a system expands into a vacuum. (c) Expansion against constant pressure Now suppose that the external pressure is constant throughout the expansion. For example, the piston may be pressed on by the atmosphere, which exerts the same pressure throughout the expansion. A chemical example of this condition is the expansion of a gas formed in a chemical reaction. We can evaluate eqn 2.6 by taking the constant pex outside the integral: w = −pexΎ Vf Vi dV = −pex(Vf − Vi) Therefore, if we write the change in volume as ∆V = Vf − Vi, w = −pex∆V (2.8) This result is illustrated graphically in Fig. 2.7, which makes use of the fact that an integral can be interpreted as an area. The magnitude of w, denoted |w|, is equal to the area beneath the horizontal line at p = pex lying between the initial and final volumes. A p,V-graph used to compute expansion work is called an indicator diagram; James Watt first used one to indicate aspects of the operation of his steam engine. (d) Reversible expansion A reversible change in thermodynamics is a change that can be reversed by an infinitesimal modification of a variable. The key word ‘infinitesimal’ sharpens the everyday meaning of the word ‘reversible’ as something that can change direction. We say that a system is in equilibrium with its surroundings if an infinitesimal change in the conditions in opposite directions results in opposite changes in its state. One example of reversibility that we have encountered already is the thermal equilibrium of two systems with the same temperature. The transfer of energy as heat between the two is reversible because, if the temperature of either system is lowered infinitesimally, then energy flows into the system with the lower temperature. If the temperature of either system at thermal equilibrium is raised infinitesimally, then energy flows out of the hotter system. Suppose a gas is confined by a piston and that the external pressure, pex, is set equal to the pressure, p, of the confined gas. Such a system is in mechanical equilibrium with its surroundings (as illustrated in Section 1.1) because an infinitesimal change in the external pressure in either direction causes changes in volume in opposite directions. If the external pressure is reduced infinitesimally, then the gas expands slightly. If the external pressure is increased infinitesimally, then the gas contracts slightly. In either case the change is reversible in the thermodynamic sense. If, on the other hand, the external pressure differs measurably from the internal pressure, then changing pex infinitesimally will not decrease it below the pressure of the gas, so will not change the direction of the process. Such a system is not in mechanical equilibrium with its surroundings and the expansion is thermodynamically irreversible. To achieve reversible expansion we set pex equal to p at each stage of the expansion. In practice, this equalization could be achieved by gradually removing weights from the piston so that the downward force due to the weights always matched the changing upward force due to the pressure of the gas. When we set pex = p, eqn 2.5 becomes dw = −pexdV = −pdV (2.9)rev (Equations valid only for reversible processes are labelled with a subscript rev.) Although the pressure inside the system appears in this expression for the work, it Comment 2.2 The value of the integral Ύ b a f(x)dx is equal to the area under the graph of f(x) between x = a and x = b. For instance, the area under the curve f(x) = x2 shown in the illustration that lies between x = 1 and 3 is Ύ 3 1 x2 dx = (1–3x3 + constant) 3 1 = 1–3(33 − 13 ) = 26––3 ≈ 8.67 Fig. 2.7 The work done by a gas when it expands against a constant external pressure, pex, is equal to the shaded area in this example of an indicator diagram. 36 2 THE FIRST LAW Comment 2.3 An integral that occurs throughout thermodynamics is Ύ b a dx = (lnx + constant) b a = ln b a 1 x Fig. 2.8 The work done by a perfect gas when it expands reversibly and isothermally is equal to the area under the isotherm p = nRT/V. The work done during the irreversible expansion against the same final pressure is equal to the rectangular area shown slightly darker. Note that the reversible work is greater than the irreversible work. Exploration Calculate the work of isothermal reversible expansion of 1.0 mol CO2(g) at 298 K from 1.0 m3 to 3.0 m3 on the basis that it obeys the van der Waals equation of state. 2 We shall see later that there is a compensating influx of energy as heat, so overall the internal energy is constant for the isothermal expansion of a perfect gas. does so only because pex has been set equal to p to ensure reversibility. The total work of reversible expansion is therefore w = − Ύ Vf Vi pdV (2.10)rev We can evaluate the integral once we know how the pressure of the confined gas depends on its volume. Equation 2.10 is the link with the material covered in Chapter 1 for, if we know the equation of state of the gas, then we can express p in terms of V and evaluate the integral. (e) Isothermal reversible expansion Consider the isothermal, reversible expansion of a perfect gas. The expansion is made isothermal by keeping the system in thermal contact with its surroundings (which may be a constant-temperature bath). Because the equation of state is pV = nRT, we know that at each stage p = nRT/V, with V the volume at that stage of the expansion. The temperature T is constant in an isothermal expansion, so (together with n and R) it may be taken outside the integral. It follows that the work of reversible isothermal expansion of a perfect gas from Vi to Vf at a temperature T is w = −nRTΎ Vf Vi = −nRT ln (2.11)°rev When the final volume is greater than the initial volume, as in an expansion, the logarithm in eqn 2.11 is positive and hence w < 0. In this case, the system has done work on the surroundings and the internal energy of the system has decreased as a result.2 The equations also show that more work is done for a given change of volume when the temperature is increased. The greater pressure of the confined gas then needs a higher opposing pressure to ensure reversibility. We can express the result of the calculation as an indicator diagram, for the magnitude of the work done is equal to the area under the isotherm p = nRT/V (Fig. 2.8). Superimposed on the diagram is the rectangular area obtained for irreversible expansion against constant external pressure fixed at the same final value as that reached in the reversible expansion. More work is obtained when the expansion is reversible (the area is greater) because matching the external pressure to the internal pressure at each stage of the process ensures that none of the system’s pushing power is wasted. We cannot obtain more work than for the reversible process because increasing the external pressure even infinitesimally at any stage results in compression. We may infer from this discussion that, because some pushing power is wasted when p > pex, the maximum work available from a system operating between specified initial and final states and passing along a specified path is obtained when the change takes place reversibly. We have introduced the connection between reversibility and maximum work for the special case of a perfect gas undergoing expansion. Later (in Section 3.5) we shall see that it applies to all substances and to all kinds of work. Example 2.1 Calculating the work of gas production Calculate the work done when 50 g of iron reacts with hydrochloric acid in (a) a closed vessel of fixed volume, (b) an open beaker at 25°C. Vf Vi dV V 2.4 HEAT TRANSACTIONS 37 Method We need to judge the magnitude of the volume change and then to decide how the process occurs. If there is no change in volume, there is no expansion work however the process takes place. If the system expands against a constant external pressure, the work can be calculated from eqn 2.8. A general feature of processes in which a condensed phase changes into a gas is that the volume of the former may usually be neglected relative to that of the gas it forms. Answer In (a) the volume cannot change, so no expansion work is done and w = 0. In (b) the gas drives back the atmosphere and therefore w = −pex∆V. We can neglect the initial volume because the final volume (after the production of gas) is so much larger and ∆V = Vf − Vi ≈ Vf = nRT/pex, where n is the amount of H2 produced. Therefore, w = −pex∆V ≈ −pex × = −nRT Because the reaction is Fe(s) + 2 HCl(aq) → FeCl2(aq) + H2(g), we know that 1 mol H2 is generated when 1 mol Fe is consumed, and n can be taken as the amount of Fe atoms that react. Because the molar mass of Fe is 55.85 g mol−1 , it follows that w ≈ − × (8.3145 J K−1 mol−1 ) × (298 K) ≈ −2.2 kJ The system (the reaction mixture) does 2.2 kJ of work driving back the atmosphere. Note that (for this perfect gas system) the magnitude of the external pressure does not affect the final result: the lower the pressure, the larger the volume occupied by the gas, so the effects cancel. Self-test 2.1 Calculate the expansion work done when 50 g of water is electrolysed under constant pressure at 25°C. [−10 kJ] 2.4 Heat transactions In general, the change in internal energy of a system is dU = dq + dwexp + dwe (2.12) where dwe is work in addition (e for ‘extra’) to the expansion work, dwexp. For instance, dwe might be the electrical work of driving a current through a circuit. A system kept at constant volume can do no expansion work, so dwexp = 0. If the system is also incapable of doing any other kind of work (if it is not, for instance, an electrochemical cell connected to an electric motor), then dwe = 0 too. Under these circumstances: dU = dq (at constant volume, no additional work) (2.13a) We express this relation by writing dU = dqV, where the subscript implies a change at constant volume. For a measurable change, ∆U = qV (2.13b) It follows that, by measuring the energy supplied to a constant-volume system as heat (q > 0) or obtained from it as heat (q < 0) when it undergoes a change of state, we are in fact measuring the change in its internal energy. 50 g 55.85 g mol−1 nRT pex 38 2 THE FIRST LAW Fig. 2.9 A constant-volume bomb calorimeter. The ‘bomb’ is the central vessel, which is strong enough to withstand high pressures. The calorimeter (for which the heat capacity must be known) is the entire assembly shown here. To ensure adiabaticity, the calorimeter is immersed in a water bath with a temperature continuously readjusted to that of the calorimeter at each stage of the combustion. Comment 2.4 Electrical charge is measured in coulombs, C. The motion of charge gives rise to an electric current, I, measured in coulombs per second, or amperes, A, where 1 A = 1 C s−1 . If a constant current I flows through a potential difference V (measured in volts, V), the total energy supplied in an interval t is Energy supplied = IV t Because 1 A V s = 1 (C s−1 ) V s = 1 C V = 1 J, the energy is obtained in joules with the current in amperes, the potential difference in volts, and the time in seconds. We write the electrical power, P, as P = (energy supplied)/(time interval) = IV t/t = IV 3 If the system can change its composition, it is necessary to distinguish between equilibrium and fixedcomposition values of CV. All applications in this chapter refer to a single substance, so this complication can be ignored. (a) Calorimetry Calorimetry is the study of heat transfer during physical and chemical processes. A calorimeter is a device for measuring energy transferred as heat. The most common device for measuring ∆U is an adiabatic bomb calorimeter (Fig. 2.9). The process we wish to study—which may be a chemical reaction—is initiated inside a constantvolume container, the ‘bomb’. The bomb is immersed in a stirred water bath, and the whole device is the calorimeter. The calorimeter is also immersed in an outer water bath. The water in the calorimeter and of the outer bath are both monitored and adjusted to the same temperature. This arrangement ensures that there is no net loss of heat from the calorimeter to the surroundings (the bath) and hence that the calorimeter is adiabatic. The change in temperature, ∆T, of the calorimeter is proportional to the heat that the reaction releases or absorbs. Therefore, by measuring ∆T we can determine qV and hence find ∆U. The conversion of ∆T to qV is best achieved by calibrating the calorimeter using a process of known energy output and determining the calorimeter constant, the constant C in the relation q = C∆T (2.14a) The calorimeter constant may be measured electrically by passing a constant current, I, from a source of known potential difference, V, through a heater for a known period of time, t, for then q = IV t (2.14b) Alternatively, C may be determined by burning a known mass of substance (benzoic acid is often used) that has a known heat output. With C known, it is simple to interpret an observed temperature rise as a release of heat. Illustration 2.2 The calibration of a calorimeter If we pass a current of 10.0 A from a 12 V supply for 300 s, then from eqn 2.14b the energy supplied as heat is q = (10.0 A) × (12 V) × (300 s) = 3.6 × 104 A V s = 36 kJ because 1 A V s = 1 J. If the observed rise in temperature is 5.5 K, then the calorimeter constant is C = (36 kJ)/(5.5 K) = 6.5 kJ K−1 . (b) Heat capacity The internal energy of a substance increases when its temperature is raised. The increase depends on the conditions under which the heating takes place and for the present we suppose that the sample is confined to a constant volume. For example, the sample may be a gas in a container of fixed volume. If the internal energy is plotted against temperature, then a curve like that in Fig. 2.10 may be obtained. The slope of the tangent to the curve at any temperature is called the heat capacity of the system at that temperature. The heat capacity at constant volume is denoted CV and is defined formally as3 2.4 HEAT TRANSACTIONS 39 Comment 2.5 The partial-differential operation (∂z/∂x)y consists of taking the first derivative of z(x,y) with respect to x, treating y as a constant. For example, if z(x,y) = x2 y, then y = y = y = 2yx Partial derivatives are reviewed in Appendix 2. dx2 dx D E F ∂[x2 y] ∂x A B C D E F ∂z ∂x A B C Fig. 2.11 The internal energy of a system varies with volume and temperature, perhaps as shown here by the surface. The variation of the internal energy with temperature at one particular constant volume is illustrated by the curve drawn parallel to T. The slope of this curve at any point is the partial derivative (∂U/∂T)V. Fig. 2.10 The internal energy of a system increases as the temperature is raised; this graph shows its variation as the system is heated at constant volume. The slope of the tangent to the curve at any temperature is the heat capacity at constant volume at that temperature. Note that, for the system illustrated, the heat capacity is greater at B than at A. CV = V [2.15] In this case, the internal energy varies with the temperature and the volume of the sample, but we are interested only in its variation with the temperature, the volume being held constant (Fig. 2.11). Illustration 2.3 Estimating a constant-volume heat capacity The heat capacity of a monatomic perfect gas can be calculated by inserting the expression for the internal energy derived in Molecular interpretation 2.2. There we saw that Um = Um(0) + 3 –2RT, so from eqn 2.15 CV,m = (Um(0) + 3 –2RT) = 3 –2R The numerical value is 12.47 J K−1 mol−1 . Heat capacities are extensive properties: 100 g of water, for instance, has 100 times the heat capacity of 1 g of water (and therefore requires 100 times the energy as heat to bring about the same rise in temperature). The molar heat capacity at constant volume, CV,m = CV/n, is the heat capacity per mole of material, and is an intensive property (all molar quantities are intensive). Typical values of CV,m for polyatomic gases are close to 25 J K−1 mol−1 . For certain applications it is useful to know the specific heat capacity (more informally, the ‘specific heat’) of a substance, which is the heat capacity of the sample divided by the mass, usually in grams: CV,s = CV/m. The specific heat capacity of water at room temperature is close to 4 J K−1 g−1 . In general, ∂ ∂T D F ∂U ∂T A C 40 2 THE FIRST LAW heat capacities depend on the temperature and decrease at low temperatures. However, over small ranges of temperature at and above room temperature, the variation is quite small and for approximate calculations heat capacities can be treated as almost independent of temperature. The heat capacity is used to relate a change in internal energy to a change in temperature of a constant-volume system. It follows from eqn 2.15 that dU = CV dT (at constant volume) (2.16a) That is, at constant volume, an infinitesimal change in temperature brings about an infinitesimal change in internal energy, and the constant of proportionality is CV. If the heat capacity is independent of temperature over the range of temperatures of interest, a measurable change of temperature, ∆T, brings about a measurable increase in internal energy, ∆U, where ∆U = CV ∆T (at constant volume) (2.16b) Because a change in internal energy can be identified with the heat supplied at constant volume (eqn 2.13b), the last equation can be written qV = CV∆T (2.17) This relation provides a simple way of measuring the heat capacity of a sample: a measured quantity of energy is transferred as heat to the sample (electrically, for example), and the resulting increase in temperature is monitored. The ratio of the energy transferred as heat to the temperature rise it causes (qV/∆T) is the constant-volume heat capacity of the sample. A large heat capacity implies that, for a given quantity of energy transferred as heat, there will be only a small increase in temperature (the sample has a large capacity for heat). An infinite heat capacity implies that there will be no increase in temperature however much energy is supplied as heat. At a phase transition, such as at the boiling point of water, the temperature of a substance does not rise as energy is supplied as heat: the energy is used to drive the endothermic transition, in this case to vaporize the water, rather than to increase its temperature. Therefore, at the temperature of a phase transition, the heat capacity of a sample is infinite. The properties of heat capacities close to phase transitions are treated more fully in Section 4.7. 2.5 Enthalpy The change in internal energy is not equal to the energy transferred as heat when the system is free to change its volume. Under these circumstances some of the energy supplied as heat to the system is returned to the surroundings as expansion work (Fig. 2.12), so dU is less than dq. However, we shall now show that in this case the energy supplied as heat at constant pressure is equal to the change in another thermodynamic property of the system, the enthalpy. (a) The definition of enthalpy The enthalpy, H, is defined as H = U + pV [2.18] where p is the pressure of the system and V is its volume. Because U, p, and V are all state functions, the enthalpy is a state function too. As is true of any state function, the change in enthalpy, ∆H, between any pair of initial and final states is independent of the path between them. Fig. 2.12 When a system is subjected to constant pressure and is free to change its volume, some of the energy supplied as heat may escape back into the surroundings as work. In such a case, the change in internal energy is smaller than the energy supplied as heat. 2.5 ENTHALPY 41 Although the definition of enthalpy may appear arbitrary, it has important implications for thermochemisty. For instance, we show in the following Justification that eqn 2.18 implies that the change in enthalpy is equal to the energy supplied as heat at constant pressure (provided the system does no additional work): dH = dq (at constant pressure, no additional work) (2.19a) For a measurable change, ∆H = qp (2.19b) Justification 2.1 The relation ∆H = qp For a general infinitesimal change in the state of the system, U changes to U + dU, p changes to p + dp, and V changes to V + dV, so from the definition in eqn 2.18, H changes from U + pV to H + dH = (U + dU) + (p + dp)(V + dV) = U + dU + pV + pdV + Vdp + dpdV The last term is the product of two infinitesimally small quantities and can therefore be neglected. As a result, after recognizing U + pV = H on the right, we find that H changes to H + dH = H + dU + pdV + Vdp and hence that dH = dU + pdV + Vdp If we now substitute dU = dq + dw into this expression, we get dH = dq + dw + pdV + Vdp If the system is in mechanical equilibrium with its surroundings at a pressure p and does only expansion work, we can write dw = −pdV and obtain dH = dq + Vdp Now we impose the condition that the heating occurs at constant pressure by writing dp = 0. Then dH = dq (at constant pressure, no additional work) as in eqn 2.19a. The result expressed in eqn 2.19 states that, when a system is subjected to a constant pressure, and only expansion work can occur, the change in enthalpy is equal to the energy supplied as heat. For example, if we supply 36 kJ of energy through an electric heater immersed in an open beaker of water, then the enthalpy of the water increases by 36 kJ and we write ∆H = +36 kJ. (b) The measurement of an enthalpy change An enthalpy change can be measured calorimetrically by monitoring the temperature change that accompanies a physical or chemical change occurring at constant pressure. A calorimeter for studying processes at constant pressure is called an isobaric calorimeter. A simple example is a thermally insulated vessel open to the atmosphere: the heat released in the reaction is monitored by measuring the change in temperature 42 2 THE FIRST LAW of the contents. For a combustion reaction an adiabatic flame calorimeter may be used to measure ∆T when a given amount of substance burns in a supply of oxygen (Fig. 2.13). Another route to ∆H is to measure the internal energy change by using a bomb calorimeter, and then to convert ∆U to ∆H. Because solids and liquids have small molar volumes, for them pVm is so small that the molar enthalpy and molar internal energy are almost identical (Hm = Um + pVm ≈ Um). Consequently, if a process involves only solids or liquids, the values of ∆H and ∆U are almost identical. Physically, such processes are accompanied by a very small change in volume, the system does negligible work on the surroundings when the process occurs, so the energy supplied as heat stays entirely within the system. The most sophisticated way to measure enthalpy changes, however, is to use a differential scanning calorimeter (DSC). Changes in enthalpy and internal energy may also be measured by noncalorimetric methods (see Chapter 7). Example 2.2 Relating ∆H and ∆U The internal energy change when 1.0 mol CaCO3 in the form of calcite converts to aragonite is +0.21 kJ. Calculate the difference between the enthalpy change and the change in internal energy when the pressure is 1.0 bar given that the densities of the solids are 2.71 g cm−3 and 2.93 g cm−3 , respectively. Method The starting point for the calculation is the relation between the enthalpy of a substance and its internal energy (eqn 2.18). The difference between the two quantities can be expressed in terms of the pressure and the difference of their molar volumes, and the latter can be calculated from their molar masses, M, and their mass densities, ρ, by using ρ = M/Vm. Answer The change in enthalpy when the transition occurs is ∆H = H(aragonite) − H(calcite) = {U(a) + pV(a)} − {U(c) + pV(c)} = ∆U + p{V(a) − V(c)} = ∆U + p∆V The volume of 1.0 mol CaCO3 (100 g) as aragonite is 34 cm3 , and that of 1.0 mol CaCO3 as calcite is 37 cm3 . Therefore, p∆V = (1.0 × 105 Pa) × (34 − 37) × 10−6 m3 = −0.3 J (because 1 Pa m3 = 1 J). Hence, ∆H − ∆U = −0.3 J which is only 0.1 per cent of the value of ∆U. We see that it is usually justifiable to ignore the difference between the enthalpy and internal energy of condensed phases, except at very high pressures, when pV is no longer negligible. Self-test 2.2 Calculate the difference between ∆H and ∆U when 1.0 mol Sn(s, grey) of density 5.75 g cm−3 changes to Sn(s, white) of density 7.31 g cm−3 at 10.0 bar. At 298 K, ∆H = +2.1 kJ. [∆H − ∆U = −4.4 J] The enthalpy of a perfect gas is related to its internal energy by using pV = nRT in the definition of H: H = U + pV = U + nRT (2.20)° Fig. 2.13 A constant-pressure flame calorimeter consists of this component immersed in a stirred water bath. Combustion occurs as a known amount of reactant is passed through to fuel the flame, and the rise of temperature is monitored. 2.5 ENTHALPY 43 This relation implies that the change of enthalpy in a reaction that produces or consumes gas is ∆H = ∆U + ∆ngRT (2.21)° where ∆ng is the change in the amount of gas molecules in the reaction. Illustration 2.4 The relation between ∆H and ∆U for gas-phase reactions In the reaction 2 H2(g) + O2(g) → 2 H2O(l), 3 mol of gas-phase molecules is replaced by 2 mol of liquid-phase molecules, so ∆ng = −3 mol. Therefore, at 298 K, when RT = 2.5 kJ mol−1 , the enthalpy and internal energy changes taking place in the system are related by ∆H − ∆U = (−3 mol) × RT ≈ −7.4 kJ Note that the difference is expressed in kilojoules, not joules as in Example 2.2. The enthalpy change is smaller (in this case, less negative) than the change in internal energy because, although heat escapes from the system when the reaction occurs, the system contracts when the liquid is formed, so energy is restored to it from the surroundings. Example 2.3 Calculating a change in enthalpy Water is heated to boiling under a pressure of 1.0 atm. When an electric current of 0.50 A from a 12 V supply is passed for 300 s through a resistance in thermal contact with it, it is found that 0.798 g of water is vaporized. Calculate the molar internal energy and enthalpy changes at the boiling point (373.15 K). Method Because the vaporization occurs at constant pressure, the enthalpy change is equal to the heat supplied by the heater. Therefore, the strategy is to calculate the energy supplied as heat (from q = IV t), express that as an enthalpy change, and then convert the result to a molar enthalpy change by division by the amount of H2O molecules vaporized. To convert from enthalpy change to internal energy change, we assume that the vapour is a perfect gas and use eqn 2.21. Answer The enthalpy change is ∆H = qp = (0.50 A) × (12 V) × (300 s) = +(0.50 × 12 × 300) J Here we have used 1 A V s = 1 J (see Comment 2.4). Because 0.798 g of water is (0.798 g)/(18.02 g mol−1 ) = (0.798/18.02) mol H2O, the enthalpy of vaporization per mole of H2O is ∆Hm = + = +41 kJ mol−1 In the process H2O(l) → H2O(g) the change in the amount of gas molecules is ∆ng = +1 mol, so ∆Um = ∆Hm − RT = +38 kJ mol−1 The plus sign is added to positive quantities to emphasize that they represent an increase in internal energy or enthalpy. Notice that the internal energy change is smaller than the enthalpy change because energy has been used to drive back the surrounding atmosphere to make room for the vapour. 0.50 × 12 × 300 J (0.798/18.02) mol 44 2 THE FIRST LAW Self-test 2.3 The molar enthalpy of vaporization of benzene at its boiling point (353.25 K) is 30.8 kJ mol−1 . What is the molar internal energy change? For how long would the same 12 V source need to supply a 0.50 A current in order to vaporize a 10 g sample? [+27.9 kJ mol−1 , 660 s] (c) The variation of enthalpy with temperature The enthalpy of a substance increases as its temperature is raised. The relation between the increase in enthalpy and the increase in temperature depends on the conditions (for example, constant pressure or constant volume). The most important condition is constant pressure, and the slope of the tangent to a plot of enthalpy against temperature at constant pressure is called the heat capacity at constant pressure, Cp, at a given temperature (Fig. 2.14). More formally: Cp = p [2.22] The heat capacity at constant pressure is the analogue of the heat capacity at constant volume, and is an extensive property.4 The molar heat capacity at constant pressure, Cp,m, is the heat capacity per mole of material; it is an intensive property. The heat capacity at constant pressure is used to relate the change in enthalpy to a change in temperature. For infinitesimal changes of temperature, dH = CpdT (at constant pressure) (2.23a) If the heat capacity is constant over the range of temperatures of interest, then for a measurable increase in temperature ∆H = Cp∆T (at constant pressure) (2.23b) Because an increase in enthalpy can be equated with the energy supplied as heat at constant pressure, the practical form of the latter equation is qp = Cp∆T (2.24) This expression shows us how to measure the heat capacity of a sample: a measured quantity of energy is supplied as heat under conditions of constant pressure (as in a sample exposed to the atmosphere and free to expand), and the temperature rise is monitored. The variation of heat capacity with temperature can sometimes be ignored if the temperature range is small; this approximation is highly accurate for a monatomic perfect gas (for instance, one of the noble gases at low pressure). However, when it is necessary to take the variation into account, a convenient approximate empirical expression is Cp,m = a + bT + (2.25) The empirical parameters a, b, and c are independent of temperature (Table 2.2). c T2 D F ∂H ∂T A C 4 As in the case of CV, if the system can change its composition it is necessary to distinguish between equilibrium and fixed-composition values. All applications in this chapter refer to pure substances, so this complication can be ignored. Fig. 2.14 The slope of the tangent to a curve of the enthalpy of a system subjected to a constant pressure plotted against temperature is the constant-pressure heat capacity. The slope may change with temperature, in which case the heat capacity varies with temperature. Thus, the heat capacities at A and B are different. For gases, at a given temperature the slope of enthalpy versus temperature is steeper than that of internal energy versus temperature, and Cp,m is larger than CV,m. 2.5 ENTHALPY 45 Synoptic Table 2.2* Temperature variation of molar heat capacities, Cp,m/(J K−1 mol−1 ) = a + bT + c/T2 a b/(10−3 K) c/(105 K2 ) C(s, graphite) 16.86 4.77 −8.54 CO2(g) 44.22 8.79 −8.62 H2O(l) 75.29 0 0 N2(g) 28.58 3.77 −0.50 * More values are given in the Data section. Example 2.4 Evaluating an increase in enthalpy with temperature What is the change in molar enthalpy of N2 when it is heated from 25°C to 100°C? Use the heat capacity information in Table 2.2. Method The heat capacity of N2 changes with temperature, so we cannot use eqn 2.23b (which assumes that the heat capacity of the substance is constant). Therefore, we must use eqn 2.23a, substitute eqn 2.25 for the temperature dependence of the heat capacity, and integrate the resulting expression from 25°C to 100°C. Answer Forconvenience,wedenotethetwotemperaturesT1 (298K)andT2 (373K). The integrals we require are Ύ H H(T1 ) (T2) dH = Ύ T2 T1 a + bT + dT Notice how the limits of integration correspond on each side of the equation: the integration over H on the left ranges from H(T1), the value of H at T1, up to H(T2), the value of H at T2, while on the right the integration over the temperature ranges from T1 to T2. Now we use the integrals Ύdx = x + constant Ύx dx = 1–2x2 + constant Ύ = − + constant to obtain H(T2) − H(T1) = a(T2 − T1) + 1–2b(T2 2 − T2 1) − c − Substitution of the numerical data results in H(373 K) = H(298 K) + 2.20 kJ mol−1 If we had assumed a constant heat capacity of 29.14 J K−1 mol−1 (the value given by eqn 2.25 at 25°C), we would have found that the two enthalpies differed by 2.19 kJ mol−1 . Self-test 2.4 At very low temperatures the heat capacity of a solid is proportional to T3 , and we can write Cp = aT3 . What is the change in enthalpy of such a substance when it is heated from 0 to a temperature T (with T close to 0)? [∆H = 1 –4aT4 ] Most systems expand when heated at constant pressure. Such systems do work on the surroundings and therefore some of the energy supplied to them as heat escapes D F 1 T1 1 T2 A C 1 x dx x2 D F c T2 A C Comment 2.6 Integrals commonly encountered in physical chemistry are listed inside the front cover. 46 2 THE FIRST LAW back to the surroundings. As a result, the temperature of the system rises less than when the heating occurs at constant volume. A smaller increase in temperature implies a larger heat capacity, so we conclude that in most cases the heat capacity at constant pressure of a system is larger than its heat capacity at constant volume. We show later (Section 2.11) that there is a simple relation between the two heat capacities of a perfect gas: Cp − CV = nR (2.26)° It follows that the molar heat capacity of a perfect gas is about 8 J K−1 mol−1 larger at constant pressure than at constant volume. Because the heat capacity at constant volume of a monatomic gas is about 12 J K−1 mol−1 , the difference is highly significant and must be taken into account. IMPACT ON BIOCHEMISTRY AND MATERIALS SCIENCE I2.1 Differential scanning calorimetry A differential scanning calorimeter (DSC) measures the energy transferred as heat to or from a sample at constant pressure during a physical or chemical change. The term ‘differential’ refers to the fact that the behaviour of the sample is compared to that of a reference material which does not undergo a physical or chemical change during the analysis. The term ‘scanning’ refers to the fact that the temperatures of the sample and reference material are increased, or scanned, during the analysis. A DSC consists of two small compartments that are heated electrically at a constant rate. The temperature, T, at time t during a linear scan is T = T0 + αt, where T0 is the initial temperature and α is the temperature scan rate (in kelvin per second, K s−1 ). A computer controls the electrical power output in order to maintain the same temperature in the sample and reference compartments throughout the analysis (see Fig. 2.15). The temperature of the sample changes significantly relative to that of the reference material if a chemical or physical process involving the transfer of energy as heat occurs in the sample during the scan. To maintain the same temperature in both compartments, excess energy is transferred as heat to or from the sample during the process. For example, an endothermic process lowers the temperature of the sample relative to that of the reference and, as a result, the sample must be heated more strongly than the reference in order to maintain equal temperatures. If no physical or chemical change occurs in the sample at temperature T, we write the heat transferred to the sample as qp = Cp∆T, where ∆T = T − T0 and we have assumed that Cp is independent of temperature. The chemical or physical process requires the transfer of qp + qp,ex, where qp,ex is excess energy transferred as heat, to attain the same change in temperature of the sample. We interpret qp,ex in terms of an apparent change in the heat capacity at constant pressure of the sample, Cp, during the temperature scan. Then we write the heat capacity of the sample as Cp + Cp,ex, and qp + qp,ex = (Cp + Cp,ex)∆T It follows that Cp,ex = = = where Pex = qp,ex/t is the excess electrical power necessary to equalize the temperature of the sample and reference compartments. A DSC trace, also called a thermogram, consists of a plot of Pex or Cp,ex against T (see Fig. 2.16). Broad peaks in the thermogram indicate processes requiring transfer of energy as heat. From eqn 2.23a, the enthalpy change associated with the process is Pex α qp,ex αt qp,ex ∆T Fig. 2.15 A differential scanning calorimeter. The sample and a reference material are heated in separate but identical metal heat sinks. The output is the difference in power needed to maintain the heat sinks at equal temperatures as the temperature rises. Fig. 2.16 A thermogram for the protein ubiquitin at pH = 2.45. The protein retains its native structure up to about 45o C and then undergoes an endothermic conformational change. (Adapted from B. Chowdhry and S. LeHarne, J. Chem. Educ. 74, 236 (1997).) 2.6 ADIABATIC CHANGES 47 Fig. 2.17 To achieve a change of state from one temperature and volume to another temperature and volume, we may consider the overall change as composed of two steps. In the first step, the system expands at constant temperature; there is no change in internal energy if the system consists of a perfect gas. In the second step, the temperature of the system is reduced at constant volume. The overall change in internal energy is the sum of the changes for the two steps. ∆H = Ύ T2 T1 Cp,exdT where T1 and T2 are, respectively, the temperatures at which the process begins and ends. This relation shows that the enthalpy change is then the area under the curve of Cp,ex against T. With a DSC, enthalpy changes may be determined in samples of masses as low as 0.5 mg, which is a significant advantage over bomb or flame calorimeters, which require several grams of material. Differential scanning calorimetry is used in the chemical industry to characterize polymers and in the biochemistry laboratory to assess the stability of proteins, nucleic acids, and membranes. Large molecules, such as synthetic or biological polymers, attain complex three-dimensional structures due to intra- and intermolecular interactions, such as hydrogen bonding and hydrophobic interactions (Chapter 18). Disruption of these interactions is an endothermic process that can be studied with a DSC. For example, the thermogram shown in the illustration indicated that the protein ubiquitin retains its native structure up to about 45°C. At higher temperatures, the protein undergoes an endothermic conformational change that results in the loss of its three-dimensional structure. The same principles also apply to the study of structural integrity and stability of synthetic polymers, such as plastics. 2.6 Adiabatic changes We are now equipped to deal with the changes that occur when a perfect gas expands adiabatically. A decrease in temperature should be expected: because work is done but no heat enters the system, the internal energy falls, and therefore the temperature of the working gas also falls. In molecular terms, the kinetic energy of the molecules falls as work is done, so their average speed decreases, and hence the temperature falls. The change in internal energy of a perfect gas when the temperature is changed from Ti to Tf and the volume is changed from Vi to Vf can be expressed as the sum of two steps (Fig. 2.17). In the first step, only the volume changes and the temperature is held constant at its initial value. However, because the internal energy of a perfect gas is independent of the volume the molecules occupy, the overall change in internal energy arises solely from the second step, the change in temperature at constant volume. Provided the heat capacity is independent of temperature, this change is ∆U = CV(Tf − Ti) = CV∆T Because the expansion is adiabatic, we know that q = 0; because ∆U = q + w, it then follows that ∆U = wad. The subscript ‘ad’ denotes an adiabatic process. Therefore, by equating the two values we have obtained for ∆U, we obtain wad = CV∆T (2.27) That is, the work done during an adiabatic expansion of a perfect gas is proportional to the temperature difference between the initial and final states. That is exactly what we expect on molecular grounds, because the mean kinetic energy is proportional to T, so a change in internal energy arising from temperature alone is also expected to be proportional to ∆T. In Further information 2.1 we show that the initial and final temperatures of a perfect gas that undergoes reversible adiabatic expansion (reversible expansion in a thermally insulated container) can be calculated from Tf = Ti 1/c (2.28a)°rev D F Vi Vf A C 48 2 THE FIRST LAW Fig. 2.18 An adiabat depicts the variation of pressure with volume when a gas expands adiabatically. (a) An adiabat for a perfect gas undergoing reversible expansion. (b) Note that the pressure declines more steeply for an adiabat than it does for an isotherm because the temperature decreases in the former. Exploration Explore how the parameter γ affects the dependence of the pressure on the volume. Does the pressure–volume dependence become stronger or weaker with increasing volume? where c = CV,m/R, or equivalently ViTi c = VfTf c (2.28b)°rev This result is often summarized in the form VTc = constant. Illustration 2.5 Work of adiabatic expansion Consider the adiabatic, reversible expansion of 0.020 mol Ar, initially at 25°C, from 0.50 dm3 to 1.00 dm3 . The molar heat capacity of argon at constant volume is 12.48 J K−1 mol−1 , so c = 1.501. Therefore, from eqn 2.28a, Tf = (298 K) × 1/1.501 = 188 K It follows that ∆T = −110 K, and therefore, from eqn 2.27, that w = {(0.020 mol) × (12.48 J K−1 mol−1 )} × (−110 K) = −27 J Note that temperature change is independent of the amount of gas but the work is not. Self-test 2.5 Calculate the final temperature, the work done, and the change of internal energy when ammonia is used in a reversible adiabatic expansion from 0.50 dm3 to 2.00 dm3 , the other initial conditions being the same. [195 K, −56 J, −56 J] We also show in Further information 2.1 that the pressure of a perfect gas that undergoes reversible adiabatic expansion from a volume Vi to a volume Vf is related to its initial pressure by pfVf γ = piV i γ (2.29)°rev where γ = Cp,m/CV,m. This result is summarized in the form pVγ = constant. For a monatomic perfect gas, CV,m = 3 –2R (see Illustration 2.3), and from eqn 2.26 Cp,m = 5 –2R; so γ = 5 –3. For a gas of nonlinear polyatomic molecules (which can rotate as well as translate), CV,m = 3R, so γ = 4 –3. The curves of pressure versus volume for adiabatic change are known as adiabats, and one for a reversible path is illustrated in Fig. 2.18. Because γ > 1, an adiabat falls more steeply (p ∝ 1/Vγ ) than the corresponding isotherm (p ∝ 1/V). The physical reason for the difference is that, in an isothermal expansion, energy flows into the system as heat and maintains the temperature; as a result, the pressure does not fall as much as in an adiabatic expansion. Illustration 2.6 The pressure change accompanying adiabatic expansion When a sample of argon (for which γ = 5 –3 ) at 100 kPa expands reversibly and adiabatically to twice its initial volume the final pressure will be pf = γ pi = 5/3 × (100 kPa) = 32 kPa For an isothermal doubling of volume, the final pressure would be 50 kPa. D F 1 2 A C D F Vi Vf A C D F 0.50 dm3 1.00 dm3 A C 2.7 STANDARD ENTHALPY CHANGES 49 Thermochemistry The study of the energy transferred as heat during the course of chemical reactions is called thermochemistry. Thermochemistry is a branch of thermodynamics because a reaction vessel and its contents form a system, and chemical reactions result in the exchange of energy between the system and the surroundings. Thus we can use calorimetry to measure the energy supplied or discarded as heat by a reaction, and can identify q with a change in internal energy (if the reaction occurs at constant volume) or a change in enthalpy (if the reaction occurs at constant pressure). Conversely, if we know ∆U or ∆H for a reaction, we can predict the energy (transferred as heat) the reaction can produce. We have already remarked that a process that releases energy by heating the surroundings is classified as exothermic and one that absorbs energy by cooling the surroundings is classified as endothermic. Because the release of energy by heating the surroundings signifies a decrease in the enthalpy of a system (at constant pressure), we can now see that an exothermic process at constant pressure is one for which ∆H < 0. Conversely, because the absorption of energy by cooling the surroundings results in an increase in enthalpy, an endothermic process at constant pressure has ∆H > 0. 2.7 Standard enthalpy changes Changes in enthalpy are normally reported for processes taking place under a set of standard conditions. In most of our discussions we shall consider the standard enthalpy change, ∆H7 , the change in enthalpy for a process in which the initial and final substances are in their standard states: The standard state of a substance at a specified temperature is its pure form at 1 bar.5 For example, the standard state of liquid ethanol at 298 K is pure liquid ethanol at 298 K and 1 bar; the standard state of solid iron at 500 K is pure iron at 500 K and 1 bar. The standard enthalpy change for a reaction or a physical process is the difference between the products in their standard states and the reactants in their standard states, all at the same specified temperature. As an example of a standard enthalpy change, the standard enthalpy of vaporization, ∆vapH7 , is the enthalpy change per mole when a pure liquid at 1 bar vaporizes to a gas at 1 bar, as in H2O(l) → H2O(g) ∆vapH7 (373 K) = +40.66 kJ mol−1 As implied by the examples, standard enthalpies may be reported for any temperature. However, the conventional temperature for reporting thermodynamic data is 298.15 K (corresponding to 25.00°C). Unless otherwise mentioned, all thermodynamic data in this text will refer to this conventional temperature. A note on good practice The attachment of the name of the transition to the symbol ∆, as in ∆vapH, is the modern convention. However, the older convention, ∆Hvap, is still widely used. The new convention is more logical because the subscript identifies the type of change, not the physical observable related to the change. 5 The definition of standard state is more sophisticated for a real gas (Further information 3.2) and for solutions (Sections 5.6 and 5.7). 50 2 THE FIRST LAW (a) Enthalpies of physical change The standard enthalpy change that accompanies a change of physical state is called the standard enthalpy of transition and is denoted ∆trsH7 (Table 2.3). The standard enthalpy of vaporization, ∆vapH7 , is one example. Another is the standard enthalpy of fusion, ∆fusH7 , the standard enthalpy change accompanying the conversion of a solid to a liquid, as in H2O(s) → H2O(l) ∆fusH7 (273 K) = +6.01 kJ mol−1 As in this case, it is sometimes convenient to know the standard enthalpy change at the transition temperature as well as at the conventional temperature. Because enthalpy is a state function, a change in enthalpy is independent of the path between the two states. This feature is of great importance in thermochemistry, for it implies that the same value of ∆H7 will be obtained however the change is brought about between the same initial and final states. For example, we can picture the conversion of a solid to a vapour either as occurring by sublimation (the direct conversion from solid to vapour), H2O(s) → H2O(g) ∆subH7 or as occurring in two steps, first fusion (melting) and then vaporization of the resulting liquid: H2O(s) → H2O(l) ∆fusH7 H2O(l) → H2O(g) ∆vapH7 Overall: H2O(s) → H2O(g) ∆fusH7 + ∆vapH7 Because the overall result of the indirect path is the same as that of the direct path, the overall enthalpy change is the same in each case (1), and we can conclude that (for processes occurring at the same temperature) ∆subH7 = ∆fusH7 + ∆vapH7 (2.30) An immediate conclusion is that, because all enthalpies of fusion are positive, the enthalpy of sublimation of a substance is greater than its enthalpy of vaporization (at a given temperature). Another consequence of H being a state function is that the standard enthalpy changes of a forward process and its reverse differ in sign (2): ∆H7 (A → B) = −∆H7 (B → A) (2.31) For instance, because the enthalpy of vaporization of water is +44 kJ mol−1 at 298 K, its enthalpy of condensation at that temperature is −44 kJ mol−1 . Synoptic Table 2.3* Standard enthalpies of fusion and vaporization at the transition temperature, ∆trsH7 /(kJ mol−1 ) Tf/K Fusion Tb/K Vaporization Ar 83.81 1.188 87.29 6.506 C6H6 278.61 10.59 353.2 30.8 H2O 273.15 6.008 373.15 40.656 (44.016 at 298 K) He 3.5 0.021 4.22 0.084 * More values are given in the Data section. 2.7 STANDARD ENTHALPY CHANGES 51 The different types of enthalpies encountered in thermochemistry are summarized in Table 2.4. We shall meet them again in various locations throughout the text. (b) Enthalpies of chemical change Now we consider enthalpy changes that accompany chemical reactions. There are two ways of reporting the change in enthalpy that accompanies a chemical reaction. One is to write the thermochemical equation, a combination of a chemical equation and the corresponding change in standard enthalpy: CH4(g) + 2 O2(g) → CO2(g) + 2 H2O(l) ∆H7 = −890 kJ ∆H7 is the change in enthalpy when reactants in their standard states change to products in their standard states: Pure, separate reactants in their standard states → pure, separate products in their standard states Except in the case of ionic reactions in solution, the enthalpy changes accompanying mixing and separation are insignificant in comparison with the contribution from the reaction itself. For the combustion of methane, the standard value refers to the reaction in which 1 mol CH4 in the form of pure methane gas at 1 bar reacts completely with 2 mol O2 in the form of pure oxygen gas to produce 1 mol CO2 as pure carbon dioxide at 1 bar and 2 mol H2O as pure liquid water at 1 bar; the numerical value is for the reaction at 298 K. Alternatively, we write the chemical equation and then report the standardreaction enthalpy, ∆rH7 . Thus, for the combustion of reaction, we write CH4(g) + 2 O2(g) → CO2(g) + 2 H2O(l) ∆rH7 = −890 kJ mol−1 For the reaction 2 A + B → 3 C + D Table 2.4 Enthalpies of transition Transition Process Symbol* Transition Phase α → phase β ∆trsH Fusion s → l ∆fusH Vaporization l → g ∆vapH Sublimation s → g ∆subH Mixing Pure → mixture ∆mixH Solution Solute → solution ∆solH Hydration X± (g) → X± (aq) ∆hydH Atomization Species(s, l, g) → atoms(g) ∆atH Ionization X(g) → X+ (g) + e− (g) ∆ionH Electron gain X(g) + e− (g) → X− (g) ∆egH Reaction Reactants → products ∆rH Combustion Compounds(s, l, g) + O2(g) → CO2(g), H2O(l, g) ∆cH Formation Elements → compound ∆fH Activation Reactants → activated complex ∆‡ H * IUPAC recommendations. In common usage, the transition subscript is often attached to ∆H, as in ∆Htrs. 52 2 THE FIRST LAW the standard reaction enthalpy is ∆rH7 = {3H7 m(C) + H7 m(D)} − {2H7 m(A) + H7 m(B)} where H7 m(J) is the standard molar enthalpy of species J at the temperature of interest. Note how the ‘per mole’ of ∆rH7 comes directly from the fact that molar enthalpies appear in this expression. We interpret the ‘per mole’ by noting the stoichiometic coefficients in the chemical equation. In this case ‘per mole’ in ∆rH7 means ‘per 2 mol A’, ‘per mole B’, ‘per 3 mol C’, or ‘per mol D’. In general, ∆rH7 = Products ∑νH7 m − Reactants ∑νH7 m (2.32) where in each case the molar enthalpies of the species are multiplied by their stoichiometric coefficients, ν.6 Some standard reaction enthalpies have special names and a particular significance. For instance, the standard enthalpy of combustion, ∆cH7 , is the standard reaction enthalpy for the complete oxidation of an organic compound to CO2 gas and liquid H2O if the compound contains C, H, and O, and to N2 gas if N is also present. An example is the combustion of glucose: C6H12O6(s) + 6 O2(g) → 6 CO2(g) + 6 H2O(l) ∆cH7 = −2808 kJ mol−1 The value quoted shows that 2808 kJ of heat is released when 1 mol C6H12O6 burns under standard conditions (at 298 K). Some further values are listed in Table 2.5. IMPACT ON BIOLOGY I2.2 Food and energy reserves The thermochemical properties of fuels Table 2.6 and foods are commonly discussed in terms of their specific enthalpy, the enthalpy of combustion per gram of material. Thus, if the standard enthalpy of combustion is ∆cH7 and the molar mass of the compound is M, then the specific enthalpy is ∆cH7 /M. Table 2.6 lists the specific enthalpies of several fuels. A typical 18–20 year old man requires a daily input of about 12 MJ; a woman of the same age needs about 9 MJ. If the entire consumption were in the form of glucose (3; which has a specific enthalpy of 16 kJ g−1 ), that would require the consumption of 750 g of glucose for a man and 560 g for a woman. In fact, digestible carbohydrates have a slightly higher specific enthalpy (17 kJ g−1 ) than glucose itself, so a carbohydrate Synoptic Table 2.5* Standard enthalpies of formation and combustion of organic compounds at 298 K ∆fH7 /(kJ mol−1 ) ∆cH7 /(kJ mol−1 ) Benzene, C6H6(l) +49.0 −3268 Ethane, C2H6(g) −84.7 −1560 Glucose, C6H12O6(s) −1274 −2808 Methane, CH4(g) −74.8 −890 Methanol, CH3OH(l) −238.7 −721 * More values are given in the Data section. 6 In this and similar expressions, all stoichiometric coefficients are positive. For a more sophisticated way of writing eqn 2.32, see Section 7.2. 2.7 STANDARD ENTHALPY CHANGES 53 diet is slightly less daunting than a pure glucose diet, as well as being more appropriate in the form of fibre, the indigestible cellulose that helps move digestion products through the intestine. The specific enthalpy of fats, which are long-chain esters like tristearin (beef fat), is much greater than that of carbohydrates, at around 38 kJ g−1 , slightly less than the value for the hydrocarbon oils used as fuel (48 kJ g−1 ). Fats are commonly used as an energy store, to be used only when the more readily accessible carbohydrates have fallen into short supply. In Arctic species, the stored fat also acts as a layer of insulation; in desert species(suchasthecamel),thefatisalsoasourceofwater,oneofitsoxidationproducts. Proteins are also used as a source of energy, but their components, the amino acids, are often too valuable to squander in this way, and are used to construct other proteins instead. When proteins are oxidized (to urea, CO(NH2)2), the equivalent enthalpy density is comparable to that of carbohydrates. The heat released by the oxidation of foods needs to be discarded in order to maintain body temperature within its typical range of 35.6–37.8°C. A variety of mechanisms contribute to this aspect of homeostasis, the ability of an organism to counteract environmental changes with physiological responses. The general uniformity of temperature throughout the body is maintained largely by the flow of blood. When heat needs to be dissipated rapidly, warm blood is allowed to flow through the capillaries of the skin, so producing flushing. Radiation is one means of discarding heat; another is evaporation and the energy demands of the enthalpy of vaporization of water. Evaporation removes about 2.4 kJ per gram of water perspired. When vigorous exercise promotes sweating (through the influence of heat selectors on the hypothalamus), 1–2 dm3 of perspired water can be produced per hour, corresponding to a heat loss of 2.4–5.0 MJ h−1 . (c) Hess’s law Standard enthalpies of individual reactions can be combined to obtain the enthalpy of another reaction. This application of the First Law is called Hess’s law: The standard enthalpy of an overall reaction is the sum of the standard enthalpies of the individual reactions into which a reaction may be divided. The individual steps need not be realizable in practice: they may be hypothetical reactions, the only requirement being that their chemical equations should balance. The thermodynamic basis of the law is the path-independence of the value of ∆rH7 and the implication that we may take the specified reactants, pass through any (possibly hypothetical) set of reactions to the specified products, and overall obtain the same change of enthalpy. The importance of Hess’s law is that information about a Table 2.6 Thermochemical properties of some fuels ∆cH7 / Specific enthalpy/ Enthalpy density/ Fuel Combustion equation (kJ mol−1 ) (kJ g−1 ) (kJ dm−3 ) Hydrogen H2(g) + 1 –2 O2(g) → H2O(l) −286 142 13 Methane CH4(g) + 2 O2(g) → CO2(g) + 2 H2O(l) −890 55 40 Octane C8H18(l) + 25 ––2 O2(g) → 8 CO2(g) + 9 H2O(l) −5471 48 3.8 × 104 Methanol CH3OH(l) + 3 –2 O2(g) → CO2(g) + 2 H2O(l) −726 23 1.8 × 104 54 2 THE FIRST LAW Comment 2.7 The NIST WebBook listed in the web site for this book links to online databases of thermochemical data. reaction of interest, which may be difficult to determine directly, can be assembled from information on other reactions. Example 2.5 Using Hess’s law The standard reaction enthalpy for the hydrogenation of propene, CH2=CHCH3(g) + H2(g) → CH3CH2CH3(g) is −124 kJ mol−1 . The standard reaction enthalpy for the combustion of propane, CH3CH2CH3(g) + 5 O2(g) → 3 CO2(g) + 4 H2O(l) is −2220 kJ mol−1 . Calculate the standard enthalpy of combustion of propene. Method The skill to develop is the ability to assemble a given thermochemical equation from others. Add or subtract the reactions given, together with any others needed, so as to reproduce the reaction required. Then add or subtract the reaction enthalpies in the same way. Additional data are in Table 2.5. Answer The combustion reaction we require is C3H6(g) + 9 –2 O2(g) → 3 CO2(g) + 3 H2O(l) This reaction can be recreated from the following sum: ∆rH7 /(kJ mol−1 ) C3H6(g) + H2(g) → C3H8(g) −124 C3H8(g) + 5 O2(g) → 3 CO2(g) + 4 H2O(l) −2220 H2O(l) → H2(g) + 1 –2 O2(g) +286 C3H6(g) + 9 –2 O2(g) → 3 CO2(g) + 3 H2O(l) −2058 Self-test 2.6 Calculate the enthalpy of hydrogenation of benzene from its enthalpy of combustion and the enthalpy of combustion of cyclohexane. [−205 kJ mol−1 ] 2.8 Standard enthalpies of formation The standard enthalpy of formation, ∆fH7 , of a substance is the standard reaction enthalpy for the formation of the compound from its elements in their reference states. The reference state of an element is its most stable state at the specified temperature and 1 bar. For example, at 298 K the reference state of nitrogen is a gas of N2 molecules, that of mercury is liquid mercury, that of carbon is graphite, and that of tin is the white (metallic) form. There is one exception to this general prescription of reference states: the reference state of phosphorus is taken to be white phosphorus despite this allotrope not being the most stable form but simply the more reproducible form of the element. Standard enthalpies of formation are expressed as enthalpies per mole of molecules or (for ionic substances) formula units of the compound. The standard enthalpy of formation of liquid benzene at 298 K, for example, refers to the reaction 6 C(s, graphite) + 3 H2(g) → C6H6(l) and is +49.0 kJ mol−1 . The standard enthalpies of formation of elements in their reference states are zero at all temperatures because they are the enthalpies of such ‘null’ reactionsasN2(g)→N2(g).SomeenthalpiesofformationarelistedinTables2.5and2.7. Synoptic Table 2.7* Standard enthalpies of formation of inorganic compounds at 298 K ∆fH7 /(kJ mol−1 ) H2O(l) −285.83 H2O(g) −187.78 NH3(g) −46.11 N2H4(l) +50.63 NO2(g) 33.18 N2O4(g) +9.16 NaCl(s) −411.15 KCl(s) −436.75 * More values are given in the Data section. 2.8 STANDARD ENTHALPIES OF FORMATION 55 The standard enthalpy of formation of ions in solution poses a special problem because it is impossible to prepare a solution of cations alone or of anions alone. This problem is solved by defining one ion, conventionally the hydrogen ion, to have zero standard enthalpy of formation at all temperatures: ∆fH7 (H+ , aq) = 0 [2.33] Thus, if the enthalpy of formation of HBr(aq) is found to be −122 kJ mol−1 , then the whole of that value is ascribed to the formation of Br− (aq), and we write ∆fH7 (Br− , aq) = −122 kJ mol−1 . That value may then be combined with, for instance, the enthalpy formation of AgBr(aq) to determine the value of ∆fH7 (Ag+ , aq), and so on. In essence, this definition adjusts the actual values of the enthalpies of formation of ions by a fixed amount, which is chosen so that the standard value for one of them, H+ (aq), has the value zero. (a) The reaction enthalpy in terms of enthalpies of formation Conceptually, we can regard a reaction as proceeding by decomposing the reactants into their elements and then forming those elements into the products. The value of ∆rH7 for the overall reaction is the sum of these ‘unforming’ and forming enthalpies. Because ‘unforming’ is the reverse of forming, the enthalpy of an unforming step is the negative of the enthalpy of formation (4). Hence, in the enthalpies of formation of substances, we have enough information to calculate the enthalpy of any reaction by using ∆rH7 = Products ∑ν∆fH7 − Reactants ∑ν∆fH7 (2.34) where in each case the enthalpies of formation of the species that occur are multiplied by their stoichiometric coefficients. Illustration 2.7 Using standard enthalpies of formation The standard reaction enthalpy of 2 HN3(l) + 2 NO(g) → H2O2(l) + 4 N2(g) is calculated as follows: ∆rH7 = {∆fH7 (H2O2,l) + 4∆fH7 (N2,g)} − {2∆fH7 (HN3,l) + 2∆fH7 (NO,g)} = {−187.78 + 4(0)} kJ mol−1 − {2(264.0) + 2(90.25)} kJ mol−1 = −896.3 kJ mol−1 (b) Enthalpies of formation and molecular modelling We have seen how to construct standard reaction enthalpies by combining standard enthalpies of formation. The question that now arises is whether we can construct standard enthalpies of formation from a knowledge of the chemical constitution of the species. The short answer is that there is no thermodynamically exact way of expressing enthalpies of formation in terms of contributions from individual atoms and bonds. In the past, approximate procedures based on mean bond enthalpies, ∆H(A-B), the average enthalpy change associated with the breaking of a specific A-B bond, A-B(g) → A(g) + B(g) ∆H(A-B) 56 2 THE FIRST LAW have been used. However, this procedure is notoriously unreliable, in part because the ∆H(A-B) are average values for a series of related compounds. Nor does the approach distinguish between geometrical isomers, where the same atoms and bonds may be present but experimentally the enthalpies of formation might be significantly different. Computer-aided molecular modelling has largely displaced this more primitive approach. Commercial software packages use the principles developed in Chapter 11 to calculate the standard enthalpy of formation of a molecule drawn on the computer screen. These techniques can be applied to different conformations of the same molecule. In the case of methylcyclohexane, for instance, the calculated conformational energy difference ranges from 5.9 to 7.9 kJ mol−1 , with the equatorial conformer having the lower standard enthalpy of formation. These estimates compare favourably with the experimental value of 7.5 kJ mol−1 . However, good agreement between calculated and experimental values is relatively rare. Computational methods almost always predict correctly which conformer is more stable but do not always predict the correct magnitude of the conformational energy difference. 2.9 The temperature-dependence of reaction enthalpies The standard enthalpies of many important reactions have been measured at different temperatures. However, in the absence of this information, standard reaction enthalpies at different temperatures may be calculated from heat capacities and the reaction enthalpy at some other temperature (Fig. 2.19). In many cases heat capacity data are more accurate that reaction enthalpies so, providing the information is available, the procedure we are about to describe is more accurate that a direct measurement of a reaction enthalpy at an elevated temperature. It follows from eqn 2.23a that, when a substance is heated from T1 to T2, its enthalpy changes from H(T1) to H(T2) = H(T1) + Ύ T2 T1 CpdT (2.35) (We have assumed that no phase transition takes place in the temperature range of interest.) Because this equation applies to each substance in the reaction, the standard reaction enthalpy changes from ∆rH7 (T1) to ∆rH7 (T2) = ∆rH7 (T1) + Ύ T2 T1 ∆rC7 pdT (2.36) where ∆rCp 7 is the difference of the molar heat capacities of products and reactants under standard conditions weighted by the stoichiometric coefficients that appear in the chemical equation: ∆rC7 p = Products ∑νC7 p,m − Reactants ∑νC7 p,m [2.37] Equation 2.36 is known as Kirchhoff’s law. It is normally a good approximation to assume that ∆rCp is independent of the temperature, at least over reasonably limited ranges, as illustrated in the following example. Although the individual heat capacities may vary, their difference varies less significantly. In some cases the temperature dependence of heat capacities is taken into account by using eqn 2.25. Fig. 2.19 An illustration of the content of Kirchhoff’s law. When the temperature is increased, the enthalpy of the products and the reactants both increase, but may do so to different extents. In each case, the change in enthalpy depends on the heat capacities of the substances. The change in reaction enthalpy reflects the difference in the changes of the enthalpies. 2.10 EXACT AND INEXACT DIFFERENTIALS 57 Fig. 2.20 As the volume and temperature of a system are changed, the internal energy changes. An adiabatic and a non-adiabatic path are shown as Path 1 and Path 2, respectively: they correspond to different values of q and w but to the same value of ∆U. Example 2.6 Using Kirchhoff’s law The standard enthalpy of formation of gaseous H2O at 298 K is −241.82 kJ mol−1 . Estimate its value at 100°C given the following values of the molar heat capacities at constant pressure: H2O(g): 33.58 J K−1 mol−1 ; H2(g): 28.84 J K−1 mol−1 ; O2(g): 29.37 J K−1 mol−1 . Assume that the heat capacities are independent of temperature. Method When ∆Cp 7 is independent of temperature in the range T1 to T2, the integral in eqn 2.36 evaluates to (T2 − T1)∆rCp 7 . Therefore, ∆rH7 (T2) = ∆rH7 (T1) + (T2 − T1)∆rCp 7 To proceed, write the chemical equation, identify the stoichiometric coefficients, and calculate ∆rCp 7 from the data. Answer The reaction is H2(g) + 1 –2 O2(g) → H2O(g), so ∆rCp 7 = C7 p,m(H2O, g) − {C7 p,m(H2, g) + 1 –2C7 p,m(O2, g)} = −9.94 J K−1 mol−1 It then follows that ∆fH7 (373 K) = −241.82 kJ mol−1 + (75 K) × (−9.94 J K−1 mol−1 ) = −242.6 kJ mol−1 Self-test 2.7 Estimate the standard enthalpy of formation of cyclohexene at 400 K from the data in Table 2.5. [−163 kJ mol−1 ] State functions and exact differentials We saw in Section 2.2 that a ‘state function’ is a property that is independent of how a sample is prepared. In general, such properties are functions of variables that define the current state of the system, such as pressure and temperature. The internal energy and enthalpy are examples of state functions, for they depend on the current state of the system and are independent of its previous history. Processes that describe the preparation of the state are called path functions. Examples of path functions are the work and heating that are done when preparing a state. We do not speak of a system in a particular state as possessing work or heat. In each case, the energy transferred as work or heat relates to the path being taken between states, not the current state itself. We can use the mathematical properties of state functions to draw far-reaching conclusions about the relations between physical properties and establish connections that may be completely unexpected. The practical importance of these results is that we can combine measurements of different properties to obtain the value of a property we require. 2.10 Exact and inexact differentials Consider a system undergoing the changes depicted in Fig. 2.20. The initial state of the system is i and in this state the internal energy is Ui. Work is done by the system as it expands adiabatically to a state f. In this state the system has an internal energy Uf and the work done on the system as it changes along Path 1 from i to f is w. Notice our use of language: U is a property of the state; w is a property of the path. Now consider another process, Path 2, in which the initial and final states are the same as those in Path 1 but in which the expansion is not adiabatic. The internal energy of both the 58 2 THE FIRST LAW initial and the final states are the same as before (because U is a state function). However, in the second path an energy q′ enters the system as heat and the work w′ is not the same as w. The work and the heat are path functions. In terms of the mountaineering analogy in Section 2.2, the change in altitude (a state function) is independent of the path, but the distance travelled (a path function) does depend on the path taken between the fixed endpoints. If a system is taken along a path (for example, by heating it), U changes from Ui to Uf, and the overall change is the sum (integral) of all the infinitesimal changes along the path: ∆U = Ύ f i dU (2.38) The value of ∆U depends on the initial and final states of the system but is independent of the path between them. This path-independence of the integral is expressed by saying that dU is an ‘exact differential’. In general, an exact differential is an infinitesimal quantity that, when integrated, gives a result that is independent of the path between the initial and final states. When a system is heated, the total energy transferred as heat is the sum of all individual contributions at each point of the path: q = Ύ f i, path dq (2.39) Notice the difference between this equation and eqn 2.38. First, we do not write ∆q, because q is not a state function and the energy supplied as heat cannot be expressed as qf − qi. Secondly, we must specify the path of integration because q depends on the path selected (for example, an adiabatic path has q = 0, whereas a nonadiabatic path between the same two states would have q ≠ 0). This path-dependence is expressed by saying that dq is an ‘inexact differential’. In general, an inexact differential is an infinitesimal quantity that, when integrated, gives a result that depends on the path between the initial and final states. Often dq is written pq to emphasize that it is inexact and requires the specification of a path. The work done on a system to change it from one state to another depends on the path taken between the two specified states; for example, in general the work is different if the change takes place adiabatically and non-adiabatically. It follows that dw is an inexact differential. It is often written pw. Example 2.7 Calculating work, heat, and internal energy Consider a perfect gas inside a cylinder fitted with a piston. Let the initial state be T, Vi and the final state be T, Vf. The change of state can be brought about in many ways, of which the two simplest are the following: Path 1, in which there is free expansion against zero external pressure; Path 2, in which there is reversible, isothermal expansion. Calculate w, q, and ∆U for each process. Method To find a starting point for a calculation in thermodynamics, it is often a good idea to go back to first principles, and to look for a way of expressing the quantity we are asked to calculate in terms of other quantities that are easier to calculate. We saw in Molecular interpretation 2.2 that the internal energy of a perfect gas depends only on the temperature and is independent of the volume those molecules occupy, so for any isothermal change, ∆U = 0. We also know that in general ∆U = q + w. The question depends on being able to combine the two 2.11 CHANGES IN INTERNAL ENERGY 59 Fig. 2.21 The partial derivative (∂U/∂V)T is the slope of U with respect to V with the temperature T held constant. Fig. 2.22 The partial derivative (∂U/∂T)V is the slope of U with respect to T with the volume V held constant. expressions. In this chapter, we derived a number of expressions for the work done in a variety of processes, and here we need to select the appropriate ones. Answer Because ∆U = 0 for both paths and ∆U = q + w, in each case q = −w. The work of free expansion is zero (Section 2.3b); so in Path 1, w = 0 and q = 0. For Path 2, the work is given by eqn 2.11, so w = −nRT ln(Vf/Vi) and consequently q = nRT ln(Vf/Vi). These results are consequences of the path independence of U, a state function, and the path dependence of q and w, which are path functions. Self-test 2.8 Calculate the values of q, w, and ∆U for an irreversible isothermal expansion of a perfect gas against a constant nonzero external pressure. [q = pex∆V, w = −pex∆V, ∆U = 0] 2.11 Changes in internal energy We begin to unfold the consequences of dU being an exact differential by exploring a closed system of constant composition (the only type of system considered in the rest of this chapter). The internal energy U can be regarded as a function of V, T, and p, but, because there is an equation of state, stating the values of two of the variables fixes the value of the third. Therefore, it is possible to write U in terms of just two independent variables: V and T, p and T, or p and V. Expressing U as a function of volume and temperature fits the purpose of our discussion. (a) General considerations When V changes to V + dV at constant temperature, U changes to U′ = U + T dV The coefficient (∂U/∂V)T, the slope of a plot of U against V at constant temperature, is the partial derivative of U with respect to V (Fig. 2.21). If, instead, T changes to T + dT at constant volume (Fig. 2.22), then the internal energy changes to D F ∂U ∂V A C 60 2 THE FIRST LAW U′ = U + V dT Now suppose that V and T both change infinitesimally (Fig. 2.23). The new internal energy, neglecting second-order infinitesimals (those proportional to dVdT), is the sum of the changes arising from each increment: U′ = U + T dV + V dT As a result of the infinitesimal changes in conditions, the internal energy U′ differs from U by the infinitesimal amount dU, so we an write U′ = U + dU. Therefore, from the last equation we obtain the very important result that dU = T dV + V dT (2.40) The interpretation of this equation is that, in a closed system of constant composition, any infinitesimal change in the internal energy is proportional to the infinitesimal changes of volume and temperature, the coefficients of proportionality being the two partial derivatives. In many cases partial derivatives have a straightforward physical interpretation, and thermodynamics gets shapeless and difficult only when that interpretation is not kept in sight. In the present case, we have already met (∂U/∂T)V in eqn 2.15, where we saw that it is the constant-volume heat capacity, CV. The other coefficient, (∂U/∂V)T, plays a major role in thermodynamics because it is a measure of the variation of the internal energy of a substance as its volume is changed at constant temperature (Fig. 2.24). We shall denote it πT and, because it has the same dimensions as pressure, call it the internal pressure: πT = T [2.41] In terms of the notation CV and πT, eqn 2.40 can now be written dU = πTdV + CVdT (2.42) (b) The Joule experiment When there are no interactions between the molecules, the internal energy is independent of their separation and hence independent of the volume of the sample (see Molecular interpretation 2.2). Therefore, for a perfect gas we can write πT = 0. The statement πT = 0 (that is, the internal energy is independent of the volume occupied by the sample) can be taken to be the definition of a perfect gas, for later we shall see that it implies the equation of state pV = nRT. If the internal energy increases (dU > 0) as the volume of the sample expands isothermally (dV > 0), which is the case when there are attractive forces between the particles, then a plot of internal energy against volume slopes upwards and πT > 0 (Fig. 2.25). James Joule thought that he could measure πT by observing the change in temperature of a gas when it is allowed to expand into a vacuum. He used two metal vessels immersed in a water bath (Fig. 2.26). One was filled with air at about 22 atm and the other was evacuated. He then tried to measure the change in temperature of the water of the bath when a stopcock was opened and the air expanded into a vacuum. He observed no change in temperature. D F ∂U ∂V A C D F ∂U ∂T A C D F ∂U ∂V A C D F ∂U ∂T A C D F ∂U ∂V A C D F ∂U ∂T A C Fig. 2.23 An overall change in U, which is denoted dU, arises when both V and T are allowed to change. If second-order infinitesimals are ignored, the overall change is the sum of changes for each variable separately. Fig. 2.24 The internal pressure, πT, is the slope of U with respect to V with the temperature T held constant. 2.11 CHANGES IN INTERNAL ENERGY 61 The thermodynamic implications of the experiment are as follows. No work was done in the expansion into a vacuum, so w = 0. No energy entered or left the system (the gas) as heat because the temperature of the bath did not change, so q = 0. Consequently, within the accuracy of the experiment, ∆U = 0. It follows that U does not change much when a gas expands isothermally and therefore that πT = 0. Joule’s experiment was crude. In particular, the heat capacity of the apparatus was so large that the temperature change that gases do in fact cause was too small to measure. From his experiment Joule extracted an essential limiting property of a gas, a property of a perfect gas, without detecting the small deviations characteristic of real gases. (c) Changes in internal energy at constant pressure Partial derivatives have many useful properties and some that we shall draw on frequently are reviewed in Appendix 2. Skilful use of them can often turn some unfamiliar quantity into a quantity that can be recognized, interpreted, or measured. As an example, suppose we want to find out how the internal energy varies with temperature when the pressure of the system is kept constant. If we divide both sides of eqn 2.42 by dT and impose the condition of constant pressure on the resulting differentials, so that dU/dT on the left becomes (∂U/∂T)p, we obtain p = πT p + CV It is usually sensible in thermodynamics to inspect the output of a manipulation like this to see if it contains any recognizable physical quantity. The partial derivative on the right in this expression is the slope of the plot of volume against temperature (at D F ∂V ∂T A C D F ∂U ∂T A C Fig. 2.26 A schematic diagram of the apparatus used by Joule in an attempt to measure the change in internal energy when a gas expands isothermally. The heat absorbed by the gas is proportional to the change in temperature of the bath. Fig. 2.25 For a perfect gas, the internal energy is independent of the volume (at constant temperature). If attractions are dominant in a real gas, the internal energy increases with volume because the molecules become farther apart on average. If repulsions are dominant, the internal energy decreases as the gas expands. 62 2 THE FIRST LAW Synoptic Table 2.8* Expansion coefficients (α) and isothermal compressibilities (κT) at 298 K α/(10−4 K−1 ) κT/(10−6 bar−1 ) Benzene 12.4 90.9 Diamond 0.030 0.185 Lead 0.861 2.18 Water 2.1 49.0 * More values are given in the Data section. 7 As for heat capacities, the expansion coefficients of a mixture depends on whether or not the composition is allowed to change. Throughout this chapter, we deal only with pure substances, so this complication can be disregarded. constant pressure). This property is normally tabulated as the expansion coefficient, α, of a substance,7 which is defined as α = p [2.43] and physically is the fractional change in volume that accompanies a rise in temperature. A large value of α means that the volume of the sample responds strongly to changes in temperature. Table 2.8 lists some experimental values of α and of the isothermal compressibility, κT (kappa), which is defined as κT = − T [2.44] The isothermal compressibility is a measure of the fractional change in volume when the pressure is increased by a small amount; the negative sign in the definition ensures that the compressibility is a positive quantity, because an increase of pressure, implying a positive dp, brings about a reduction of volume, a negative dV. Example 2.8 Calculating the expansion coefficient of a gas Derive an expression for the expansion coefficient of a perfect gas. Method The expansion coefficient is defined in eqn 2.43. To use this expression, substitute the expression for V in terms of T obtained from the equation of state for the gas. As implied by the subscript in eqn 2.43, the pressure, p, is treated as a constant. Answer Because pV = nRT, we can write α = p = × = = The higher the temperature, the less responsive is the volume of a perfect gas to a change in temperature. Self-test 2.9 Derive an expression for the isothermal compressibility of a perfect gas. [κT. = 1/p] When we introduce the definition of α into the equation for (∂U/∂T)p, we obtain p = απTV + CV (2.45) This equation is entirely general (provided the system is closed and its composition is constant). It expresses the dependence of the internal energy on the temperature at constant pressure in terms of CV, which can be measured in one experiment, in terms of α, which can be measured in another, and in terms of the quantity πT. For a perfect gas, πT = 0, so then p = CV (2.46)° D F ∂U ∂T A C D F ∂U ∂T A C 1 T nR pV dT dT nR p 1 V D F ∂(nRT/p) ∂T A C 1 V D F ∂V ∂p A C 1 V D F ∂V ∂T A C 1 V 2.12 THE JOULE–THOMSON EFFECT 63 That is, although the constant-volume heat capacity of a perfect gas is defined as the slope of a plot of internal energy against temperature at constant volume, for a perfect gas CV is also the slope at constant pressure. Equation 2.46 provides an easy way to derive the relation between Cp and CV for a perfect gas expressed in eqn 2.26. Thus, we can use it to express both heat capacities in terms of derivatives at constant pressure: Cp − CV = p − p (2.47)° Then we introduce H = U + pV = U + nRT into the first term, which results in Cp − CV = p + nR − p = nR (2.48)° which is eqn 2.26. We show in Further information 2.2 that in general Cp − CV = (2.49) Equation 2.49 applies to any substance (that is, it is ‘universally true’). It reduces to eqn 2.48 for a perfect gas when we set α = 1/T and κT = 1/p. Because expansion coefficients α of liquids and solids are small, it is tempting to deduce from eqn 2.49 that for them Cp ≈ CV. But this is not always so, because the compressibility κT might also be small, so α2 /κT might be large. That is, although only a little work need be done to push back the atmosphere, a great deal of work may have to be done to pull atoms apart from one another as the solid expands. As an illustration, for water at 25°C, eqn 2.49 gives Cp,m = 75.3 J K−1 mol−1 compared with CV,m = 74.8 J K−1 mol−1 . In some cases, the two heat capacities differ by as much as 30 per cent. 2.12 The Joule–Thomson effect We can carry out a similar set of operations on the enthalpy, H = U + pV. The quantities U, p, and V are all state functions; therefore H is also a state function and dH is an exact differential. It turns out that H is a useful thermodynamic function when the pressure is under our control: we saw a sign of that in the relation ∆H = qp (eqn 2.19). We shall therefore regard H as a function of p and T, and adapt the argument in Section 2.10 to find an expression for the variation of H with temperature at constant volume. As set out in Justification 2.2, we find that for a closed system of constant composition, dH = −µCpdp + CpdT (2.50) where the Joule–Thomson coefficient, µ (mu), is defined as µ = H [2.51] This relation will prove useful for relating the heat capacities at constant pressure and volume and for a discussion of the liquefaction of gases. Justification 2.2 The variation of enthalpy with pressure and temperature By the same argument that led to eqn 2.40 but with H regarded as a function of p and T we can write dH = T dp + p dT (2.52) D E F ∂H ∂T A B C D E F ∂H ∂p A B C D F ∂T ∂p A C α2 TV κT D F ∂U ∂T A C D F ∂U ∂T A C D F ∂U ∂T A C D F ∂H ∂T A C 64 2 THE FIRST LAW Fig. 2.27 The apparatus used for measuring the Joule–Thomson effect. The gas expands through the porous barrier, which acts as a throttle, and the whole apparatus is thermally insulated. As explained in the text, this arrangement corresponds to an isenthalpic expansion (expansion at constant enthalpy). Whether the expansion results in a heating or a cooling of the gas depends on the conditions. The second partial derivative is Cp; our task here is to express (∂H/∂p)T in terms of recognizable quantities. The chain relation (see Further information 2.2) lets us write T = − and both partial derivatives can be brought into the numerator by using the reciprocal identity (see Further information 2.2) twice: T = − = H p = −µCp (2.53) We have used the definitions of the constant-pressure heat capacity, Cp, and the Joule–Thomson coefficient, µ (eqn 2.51). Equation 2.50 now follows directly. The analysis of the Joule–Thomson coefficient is central to the technological problems associated with the liquefaction of gases. We need to be able to interpret it physically and to measure it. As shown in the Justification below, the cunning required to impose the constraint of constant enthalpy, so that the process is isenthalpic, was supplied by Joule and William Thomson (later Lord Kelvin). They let a gas expand through a porous barrier from one constant pressure to another, and monitored the difference of temperature that arose from the expansion (Fig. 2.27). The whole apparatus was insulated so that the process was adiabatic. They observed a lower temperature on the low pressure side, the difference in temperature being proportional to the pressure difference they maintained. This cooling by isenthalpic expansion is now called the Joule–Thomson effect. Justification 2.3 The Joule–Thomson effect Here we show that the experimental arrangement results in expansion at constant enthalpy. Because all changes to the gas occur adiabatically, q = 0, which implies ∆U = w Consider the work done as the gas passes through the barrier. We focus on the passage of a fixed amount of gas from the high pressure side, where the pressure is pi, the temperature Ti, and the gas occupies a volume Vi (Fig. 2.28). The gas emerges on the low pressure side, where the same amount of gas has a pressure pf, a temperature Tf, and occupies a volume Vf. The gas on the left is compressed isothermally by the upstream gas acting as a piston. The relevant pressure is pi and the volume changes from Vi to 0; therefore, the work done on the gas is w1 = −pi(0 − Vi) = piVi The gas expands isothermally on the right of the barrier (but possibly at a different constant temperature) against the pressure pf provided by the downstream gas acting as a piston to be driven out. The volume changes from 0 to Vf, so the work done on the gas in this stage is w2 = −pf(Vf − 0) = −pfVf The total work done on the gas is the sum of these two quantities, or w = w1 + w2 = piVi − pfVf D E F ∂H ∂T A B C D E F ∂T ∂p A B C (∂T/∂p)H (∂T/∂H)p D E F ∂H ∂p A B C 1 (∂p/∂T)H(∂T/∂H)p D E F ∂H ∂p A B C 2.12 THE JOULE–THOMSON EFFECT 65 Fig. 2.28 The thermodynamic basis of Joule–Thomson expansion. The pistons represent the upstream and downstream gases, which maintain constant pressures either side of the throttle. The transition from the top diagram to the bottom diagram, which represents the passage of a given amount of gas through the throttle, occurs without change of enthalpy. Fig. 2.29 The isothermal Joule–Thomson coefficient is the slope of the enthalpy with respect to changing pressure, the temperature being held constant. Fig. 2.30 A schematic diagram of the apparatus used for measuring the isothermal Joule–Thomson coefficient. The electrical heating required to offset the cooling arising from expansion is interpreted as ∆H and used to calculate (∂H/∂p)T, which is then converted to µ as explained in the text. It follows that the change of internal energy of the gas as it moves adiabatically from one side of the barrier to the other is Uf − Ui = w = piVi − pfVf Reorganization of this expression gives Uf + pfVf = Ui + piVi, or Hf = Hi Therefore, the expansion occurs without change of enthalpy. The property measured in the experiment is the ratio of the temperature change to the change of pressure, ∆T/∆p. Adding the constraint of constant enthalpy and taking the limit of small ∆p implies that the thermodynamic quantity measured is (∂T/∂p)H, which is the Joule–Thomson coefficient, µ. In other words, the physical interpretation of µ is that it is the ratio of the change in temperature to the change in pressure when a gas expands under conditions that ensure there is no change in enthalpy. The modern method of measuring µ is indirect, and involves measuring the isothermal Joule–Thomson coefficient, the quantity µT = T [2.54] which is the slope of a plot of enthalpy against pressure at constant temperature (Fig. 2.29). Comparing eqns 2.53 and 2.54, we see that the two coefficients are related by: µT = −Cpµ (2.55) To measure µT, the gas is pumped continuously at a steady pressure through a heat exchanger (which brings it to the required temperature), and then through a porous plug inside a thermally insulated container. The steep pressure drop is measured, and the cooling effect is exactly offset by an electric heater placed immediately after the plug (Fig. 2.30). The energy provided by the heater is monitored. Because the energy transferred as heat can be identified with the value of ∆H for the gas (because D F ∂H ∂p A C 66 2 THE FIRST LAW ∆H = qp), and the pressure change ∆p is known, we can find µT from the limiting value of ∆H/∆p as ∆p → 0, and then convert it to µ. Table 2.9 lists some values obtained in this way. Real gases have nonzero Joule–Thomson coefficients. Depending on the identity of the gas, the pressure, the relative magnitudes of the attractive and repulsive intermolecular forces (see Molecular interpretation 2.1), and the temperature, the sign of the coefficient may be either positive or negative (Fig. 2.31). A positive sign implies that dT is negative when dp is negative, in which case the gas cools on expansion. Gases that show a heating effect (µ < 0) at one temperature show a cooling effect (µ > 0) when the temperature is below their upper inversion temperature, TI (Table 2.9, Fig. 2.32). As indicated in Fig. 2.32, a gas typically has two inversion temperatures, one at high temperature and the other at low. The ‘Linde refrigerator’ makes use of Joule–Thompson expansion to liquefy gases (Fig. 2.33). The gas at high pressure is allowed to expand through a throttle; it cools and is circulated past the incoming gas. That gas is cooled, and its subsequent expansion cools it still further. There comes a stage when the circulating gas becomes so cold that it condenses to a liquid. For a perfect gas, µ = 0; hence, the temperature of a perfect gas is unchanged by Joule–Thomson expansion.8 This characteristic points clearly to the involvement of intermolecular forces in determining the size of the effect. However, the Joule– Thomson coefficient of a real gas does not necessarily approach zero as the pressure is reduced even though the equation of state of the gas approaches that of a perfect gas. The coefficient behaves like the properties discussed in Section 1.3b in the sense that it depends on derivatives and not on p, V, and T themselves. Fig. 2.31 The sign of the Joule–Thomson coefficient, µ, depends on the conditions. Inside the boundary, the shaded area, it is positive and outside it is negative. The temperature corresponding to the boundary at a given pressure is the ‘inversion temperature’ of the gas at that pressure. For a given pressure, the temperature must be below a certain value if cooling is required but, if it becomes too low, the boundary is crossed again and heating occurs. Reduction of pressure under adiabatic conditions moves the system along one of the isenthalps, or curves of constant enthalpy. The inversion temperature curve runs through the points of the isenthalps where their slope changes from negative to positive. Synoptic Table 2.9* Inversion temperatures (TI), normal freezing (Tf) and boiling (Tb) points, and Joule–Thomson coefficient (µ) at 1 atm and 298 K TI/K Tf/K Tb/K µ/(K bar−1 ) Ar 723 83.8 87.3 CO2 1500 194.7 +1.10 He 40 4.2 −0.060 N2 621 63.3 77.4 +0.25 * More values are given in the Data section. 8 Simple adiabatic expansion does cool a perfect gas, because the gas does work; recall Section 2.6. Fig. 2.32 The inversion temperatures for three real gases, nitrogen, hydrogen, and helium. Fig. 2.33 The principle of the Linde refrigerator is shown in this diagram. The gas is recirculated, and so long as it is beneath its inversion temperature it cools on expansion through the throttle. The cooled gas cools the high-pressure gas, which cools still further as it expands. Eventually liquefied gas drips from the throttle. CHECKLIST OF KEY IDEAS 67 Checklist of key ideas 1. Thermodynamics is the study of the transformations of energy. 2. The system is the part of the world in which we have a special interest. The surroundings is the region outside the system where we make our measurements. 3. An open system has a boundary through which matter can be transferred. A closed system has a boundary through which matter cannot be transferred. An isolated system has a boundary through which neither matter nor energy can be transferred. 4. Energy is the capacity to do work. The internal energy is the total energy of a system. 5. Work is the transfer of energy by motion against an opposing force, dw = −Fdz . Heat is the transfer of energy as a result of a temperature difference between the system and the surroundings. 6. An exothermic process releases energy as heat to the surroundings. An endothermic process absorbs energy as heat from the surroundings. 7. A state function is a property that depends only on the current state of the system and is independent of how that state has been prepared. 8. The First Law of thermodynamics states that the internal energy of an isolated system is constant, ∆U = q + w. 9. Expansion work is the work of expansion (or compression) of a system, dw = −pexdV. The work of free expansion is w = 0. The work of expansion against a constant external pressure is w = −pex∆V. The work of isothermal reversible expansion of a perfect gas is w = −nRT ln(Vf/Vi). 10. A reversible change is a change that can be reversed by an infinitesimal modification of a variable. 11. Maximum work is achieved in a reversible change. Molecular interpretation 2.3 Molecular interactions and the Joule–Thomson effect The kinetic model of gases (Molecular interpretation 1.1) and the equipartition theorem (Molecular interpretation 2.2) imply that the mean kinetic energy of molecules in a gas is proportional to the temperature. It follows that reducing the average speed of the molecules is equivalent to cooling the gas. If the speed of the molecules can be reduced to the point that neighbours can capture each other by their intermolecular attractions, then the cooled gas will condense to a liquid. To slow the gas molecules, we make use of an effect similar to that seen when a ball is thrown into the air: as it rises it slows in response to the gravitational attraction of the Earth and its kinetic energy is converted into potential energy. We saw in Section 1.3 that molecules in a real gas attract each other (the attraction is not gravitational, but the effect is the same). It follows that, if we can cause the molecules to move apart from each other, like a ball rising from a planet, then they should slow. It is very easy to move molecules apart from each other: we simply allow the gas to expand, which increases the average separation of the molecules. To cool a gas, therefore, we allow it to expand without allowing any energy to enter from outside as heat. As the gas expands, the molecules move apart to fill the available volume, struggling as they do so against the attraction of their neighbours. Because some kinetic energy must be converted into potential energy to reach greater separations, the molecules travel more slowly as their separation increases. This sequence of molecular events explains the Joule–Thomson effect: the cooling of a real gas by adiabatic expansion. The cooling effect, which corresponds to µ > 0, is observed under conditions when attractive interactions are dominant (Z < 1, eqn 1.17), because the molecules have to climb apart against the attractive force in order for them to travel more slowly. For molecules under conditions when repulsions are dominant (Z > 1), the Joule–Thomson effect results in the gas becoming warmer, or µ < 0. 68 2 THE FIRST LAW 12. Calorimetry is the study of heat transfers during physical and chemical processes. 13. The heat capacity at constant volume is defined as CV = (∂U/∂T)V. The heat capacity at constant pressure is Cp = (∂H/∂T)p. For a perfect gas, the heat capacities are related by Cp − CV = nR. 14. The enthalpy is defined as H = U + pV. The enthalpy change is the energy transferred as heat at constant pressure, ∆H = qp. 15. During a reversible adiabatic change, the temperature of a perfect gas varies according to Tf = Ti(Vi/Vf)1/c , c = CV,m/R. The pressure and volume are related by pVγ = constant, with γ = Cp,m/CV,m. 16. The standard enthalpy change is the change in enthalpy for a process in which the initial and final substances are in their standard states. The standard state is the pure substance at 1 bar. 17. Enthalpy changes are additive, as in ∆subH7 = ∆fusH7 + ∆vapH7 . 18. The enthalpy change for a process and its reverse are related by ∆forwardH7 = −∆reverseH7 . 19. The standard enthalpy of combustion is the standard reaction enthalpy for the complete oxidation of an organic compound to CO2 gas and liquid H2O if the compound contains C, H, and O, and to N2 gas if N is also present. 20. Hess’s law states that the standard enthalpy of an overall reaction is the sum of the standard enthalpies of the individual reactions into which a reaction may be divided. 21. The standard enthalpy of formation (∆fH7 ) is the standard reaction enthalpy for the formation of the compound from its elements in their reference states. The reference state is the most stable state of an element at the specified temperature and 1 bar. 22. The standard reaction enthalpy may be estimated by combining enthalpies of formation, ∆rH7 = ∑Productsν∆fH7 − ∑Reactantsν∆fH7 . 23. The temperature dependence of the reaction enthalpy is given by Kirchhoff’s law, ∆rH7 (T2) = ∆rH7 (T1) + Ύ T2 T1 ∆rC7 pdT. 24. An exact differential is an infinitesimal quantity that, when integrated, gives a result that is independent of the path between the initial and final states. An inexact differential is an infinitesimal quantity that, when integrated, gives a result that depends on the path between the initial and final states. 25. The internal pressure is defined as πT = (∂U/∂V)T . For a perfect gas, πT = 0. 26. The Joule–Thomson effect is the cooling of a gas by isenthalpic expansion. 27. The Joule–Thomson coefficient is defined as µ = (∂T/∂p)H. The isothermal Joule–Thomson coefficient is defined as µT = (∂H/∂p)T = −Cpµ. 28. The inversion temperature is the temperature at which the Joule–Thomson coefficient changes sign. Further reading Articles and texts P.W. Atkins and J.C. de Paula, Physical chemistry for the life sciences. W.H. Freeman, New York (2005). G.A. Estèvez, K. Yang, and B.B. Dasgupta, Thermodynamic partial derivatives and experimentally measurable quantities. J. Chem. Educ. 66, 890 (1989). I.M. Klotz and R.M. Rosenberg, Chemical thermodynamics: basic theory and methods. Wiley–Interscience, New York (2000). G.N. Lewis and M. Randall, Thermodynamics. Revised by K.S. Pitzer and L. Brewer. McGraw–Hill, New York (1961). J. Wisniak, The Joule–Thomson coefficient for pure gases and their mixtures. J. Chem. Educ. 4, 51 (1999). Sources of data and information M.W. Chase, Jr. (ed.), NIST–JANAF thermochemical tables. Published as J. Phys. Chem. Ref. Data, Monograph no. 9. American Institute of Physics, New York (1998). J.D. Cox, D.D. Wagman, and V.A. Medvedev, CODATA key values for thermodynamics. Hemisphere Publishing Corp., New York (1989). D.B. Wagman, W.H. Evans, V.B. Parker, R.H. Schumm, I. Halow, S.M. Bailey, K.L. Churney, and R.L. Nuttall, The NBS tables of chemical thermodynamic properties. Published as J. Phys. Chem. Ref. Data 11, Supplement 2 (1982). R.C. Weast (ed.), Handbook of chemistry and physics, Vol. 81. CRC Press, Boca Raton (2000). M. Zabransky, V. Ruzicka Jr., V. Majer, and E. S. Domalski. Heat capacity of liquids. Published as J. Phys. Chem. Ref. Data, Monograph no. 6. American Institute of Physics, New York (1996). FURTHER INFORMATION 69 Further information Further information 2.1 Adiabatic processes Consider a stage in a reversible adiabatic expansion when the pressure inside and out is p. The work done when the gas expands by dV is dw = −pdV; however, for a perfect gas, dU = CVdT. Therefore, because for an adiabatic change (dq = 0) dU = dw + dq = dw, we can equate these two expressions for dU and write CVdT = −pdV We are dealing with a perfect gas, so we can replace p by nRT/V and obtain = − To integrate this expression we note that T is equal to Ti when V is equal to Vi, and is equal to Tf when V is equal to Vf at the end of the expansion. Therefore, CVΎ Tf Ti = −nR Ύ Vf Vi (We are taking CV to be independent of temperature.) Then, because ∫dx/x = ln x + constant, we obtain CV ln = −nR ln Because ln(x/y) = −ln(y/x), this expression rearranges to ln = ln With c = CV /nR we obtain (because ln xa = a ln x) ln c = ln which implies that (Tf /Ti)c = (Vi/Vf) and, upon rearrangement, eqn 2.28. The initial and final states of a perfect gas satisfy the perfect gas law regardless of how the change of state takes place, so we can use pV = nRT to write = However, we have just shown that = 1/c = γ−1 where we use the definition of the heat capacity ratio where γ = Cp,m/CV,m and the fact that, for a perfect gas, Cp,m – CV,m = R (the molar version of eqn 2.26). Then we combine the two expressions, to obtain = × γ−1 = γ which rearranges to piVi γ = pfV f γ , which is eqn 2.29. D E F Vf Vi A B C D E F Vf Vi A B C Vf Vi pi pf D E F Vf Vi A B C D E F Vf Vi A B C Ti Tf Ti Tf piVi pfVf D E F Vi Vf A B C D E F Tf Ti A B C Vi Vf Tf Ti CV nR Vf Vi Tf Ti dV V dT T nRdV V CVdT T Further information 2.2 The relation between heat capacities A useful rule when doing a problem in thermodynamics is to go back to first principles. In the present problem we do this twice, first by expressing Cp and CV in terms of their definitions and then by inserting the definition H = U + pV: Cp − CV = p − V = p + p − V We have already calculated the difference of the first and third terms on the right, and eqn 2.45 lets us write this difference as απTV. The factor αV gives the change in volume when the temperature is raised, and πT = (∂U/∂V)T converts this change in volume into a change in internal energy. We can simplify the remaining term by noting that, because p is constant, p = p p = αpV The middle term of this expression identifies it as the contribution to the work of pushing back the atmosphere: (∂V/∂T)p is the change of volume caused by a change of temperature, and multiplication by p converts this expansion into work. Collecting the two contributions gives Cp − CV = α(p + πT)V (2.56) As just remarked, the first term on the right, αpV, is a measure of the work needed to push back the atmosphere; the second term on the right, απTV, is the work required to separate the molecules composing the system. At this point we can go further by using the result we prove in Section 3.8 that πT = T V − p When this expression is inserted in the last equation we obtain Cp − CV = αTV V (2.57) We now transform the remaining partial derivative. It follows from Euler’s chain relation that V p T = −1 Comment 2.8 The Euler chain relation states that, for a differentiable function z = z(x,y), z y x = −1 For instance, if z(x,y) = x2 y, D E F ∂z ∂y A B C D E F ∂x ∂z A B C D E F ∂y ∂x A B C D E F ∂V ∂p A B C D E F ∂T ∂V A B C D E F ∂p ∂T A B C D E F ∂p ∂T A B C D E F ∂p ∂T A B C D E F ∂V ∂T A B C D E F ∂(pV) ∂T A B C D E F ∂U ∂T A B C D E F ∂(pV) ∂T A B C D E F ∂U ∂T A B C D E F ∂U ∂T A B C D E F ∂H ∂T A B C 70 2 THE FIRST LAW z = z = z = − y = y = = x = x = x2 = x2 Multiplication of the three terms together gives the result −1. and therefore that V = − Unfortunately, (∂T/∂V)p occurs instead of (∂V/∂T)p. However, the ‘reciprocal identity’ allows us to invert partial derivatives and to write V = − = α κT (∂V/∂T)p (∂V/∂p)T D E F ∂p ∂T A B C 1 (∂T/∂V)p(∂V/∂p)T D E F ∂p ∂T A B C dy dy D E F ∂(x2 y) ∂y A B C D E F ∂z ∂y A B C 1 2(yz)1/2 dz1/2 dz 1 y1/2 D E F ∂(z/y)1/2 ∂z A B C D E F ∂x ∂z A B C 2z x3 d(1/x2 ) dx D E F ∂(z/x2 ) ∂x A B C D E F ∂y ∂x A B C Comment 2.9 The reciprocal identity states that z = For example, for the function z(x,y) = x2 y, z = z = z = − We can also write x = (z/y)1/2 , in which case z = z = z1/2 = − = − = − which is the reciprocal of the coefficient derived above. Insertion of this relation into eqn 2.57 produces eqn 2.49. x3 2z z1/2 2(z/x2 )3/2 z1/2 2y3/2 d(1/y1/2 ) dy D E F ∂(z/y)1/2 ∂y A B C D E F ∂x ∂y A B C 2z x3 d(1/x2 ) dx D E F ∂(z/x2 ) ∂x A B C D E F ∂y ∂x A B C 1 (∂x/∂y)z D E F ∂y ∂x A B C Discussion questions 2.1 Provide mechanical and molecular definitions of work and heat. 2.2 Consider the reversible expansion of a perfect gas. Provide a physical interpretation for the fact that pVγ = constant for an adiabatic change, whereas pV = constant for an isothermal change. 2.3 Explain the difference between the change in internal energy and the change in enthalpy accompanying a chemical or physical process. 2.4 Explain the significance of a physical observable being a state function and compile a list of as many state functions as you can identify. 2.5 Explain the significance of the Joule and Joule–Thomson experiments. What would Joule observe in a more sensitive apparatus? 2.6 Suggest (with explanation) how the internal energy of a van der Waals gas should vary with volume at constant temperature. 2.7 In many experimental thermograms, such as that shown in Fig. 2.16, the baseline below T1 is at a different level from that above T2. Explain this observation. Exercises Assume all gases are perfect unless stated otherwise. Unless otherwise stated, thermochemical data are for 298.15 K. 2.1(a) Calculate the work needed for a 65 kg person to climb through 4.0 m on the surface of (a) the Earth and (b) the Moon (g = 1.60 m s−2 ). 2.1(b) Calculate the work needed for a bird of mass 120 g to fly to a height of 50 m from the surface of the Earth. 2.2(a) A chemical reaction takes place in a container of cross-sectional area 100 cm2 . As a result of the reaction, a piston is pushed out through 10 cm against an external pressure of 1.0 atm. Calculate the work done by the system. 2.2(b) A chemical reaction takes place in a container of cross-sectional area 50.0 cm2 . As a result of the reaction, a piston is pushed out through 15 cm against an external pressure of 121 kPa. Calculate the work done by the system. 2.3(a) A sample consisting of 1.00 mol Ar is expanded isothermally at 0°C from 22.4 dm3 to 44.8 dm3 (a) reversibly, (b) against a constant external pressure equal to the final pressure of the gas, and (c) freely (against zero external pressure). For the three processes calculate q, w, ∆U, and ∆H. 2.3(b) A sample consisting of 2.00 mol He is expanded isothermally at 22°C from 22.8 dm3 to 31.7 dm3 (a) reversibly, (b) against a constant external pressure equal to the final pressure of the gas, and (c) freely (against zero external pressure). For the three processes calculate q, w, ∆U, and ∆H. 2.4(a) A sample consisting of 1.00 mol of perfect gas atoms, for which CV,m = 3 –2R, initially at p1 = 1.00 atm and T1 = 300 K, is heated reversibly to 400 K at constant volume. Calculate the final pressure, ∆U, q, and w. 2.4(b) A sample consisting of 2.00 mol of perfect gas molecules, for which CV,m = 5 –2R, initially at p1 = 111 kPa and T1 = 277 K, is heated reversibly to 356 K at constant volume. Calculate the final pressure, ∆U, q, and w. 2.5(a) A sample of 4.50 g of methane occupies 12.7 dm3 at 310 K. (a) Calculate the work done when the gas expands isothermally against a constant external pressure of 200 Torr until its volume has increased by 3.3 dm3 . (b) Calculate the work that would be done if the same expansion occurred reversibly. 2.5(b) A sample of argon of mass 6.56 g occupies 18.5 dm3 at 305 K. (a) Calculate the work done when the gas expands isothermally against a EXERCISES 71 constant external pressure of 7.7 kPa until its volume has increased by 2.5 dm3 . (b) Calculate the work that would be done if the same expansion occurred reversibly. 2.6(a) A sample of 1.00 mol H2O(g) is condensed isothermally and reversibly to liquid water at 100°C. The standard enthalpy of vaporization of water at 100°C is 40.656 kJ mol−1 . Find w, q, ∆U, and ∆H for this process. 2.6(b) A sample of 2.00 mol CH3OH(g) is condensed isothermally and reversibly to liquid at 64°C. The standard enthalpy of vaporization of methanol at 64°C is 35.3 kJ mol−1 . Find w, q, ∆U, and ∆H for this process. 2.7(a) A strip of magnesium of mass 15 g is dropped into a beaker of dilute hydrochloric acid. Calculate the work done by the system as a result of the reaction. The atmospheric pressure is 1.0 atm and the temperature 25°C. 2.7(b) A piece of zinc of mass 5.0 g is dropped into a beaker of dilute hydrochloric acid. Calculate the work done by the system as a result of the reaction. The atmospheric pressure is 1.1 atm and the temperature 23°C. 2.8(a) The constant-pressure heat capacity of a sample of a perfect gas was found to vary with temperature according to the expression Cp/(J K−1 ) = 20.17 + 0.3665(T/K). Calculate q, w, ∆U, and ∆H when the temperature is raised from 25°C to 200°C (a) at constant pressure, (b) at constant volume. 2.8(b) The constant-pressure heat capacity of a sample of a perfect gas was found to vary with temperature according to the expression Cp/(J K−1 ) = 20.17 + 0.4001(T/K). Calculate q, w, ∆U, and ∆H when the temperature is raised from 0°C to 100°C (a) at constant pressure, (b) at constant volume. 2.9(a) Calculate the final temperature of a sample of argon of mass 12.0 g that is expanded reversibly and adiabatically from 1.0 dm3 at 273.15 K to 3.0 dm3 . 2.9(b) Calculate the final temperature of a sample of carbon dioxide of mass 16.0 g that is expanded reversibly and adiabatically from 500 cm3 at 298.15 K to 2.00 dm3 . 2.10(a) A sample of carbon dioxide of mass 2.45 g at 27.0°C is allowed to expand reversibly and adiabatically from 500 cm3 to 3.00 dm3 . What is the work done by the gas? 2.10(b) A sample of nitrogen of mass 3.12 g at 23.0°C is allowed to expand reversibly and adiabatically from 400 cm3 to 2.00 dm3 . What is the work done by the gas? 2.11(a) Calculate the final pressure of a sample of carbon dioxide that expands reversibly and adiabatically from 57.4 kPa and 1.0 dm3 to a final volume of 2.0 dm3 . Take γ = 1.4. 2.11(b) Calculate the final pressure of a sample of water vapour that expands reversibly and adiabatically from 87.3 Torr and 500 cm3 to a final volume of 3.0 dm3 . Take γ = 1.3. 2.12(a) When 229 J of energy is supplied as heat to 3.0 mol Ar(g), the temperature of the sample increases by 2.55 K. Calculate the molar heat capacities at constant volume and constant pressure of the gas. 2.12(b) When 178 J of energy is supplied as heat to 1.9 mol of gas molecules, the temperature of the sample increases by 1.78 K. Calculate the molar heat capacities at constant volume and constant pressure of the gas. 2.13(a) When 3.0 mol O2 is heated at a constant pressure of 3.25 atm, its temperature increases from 260 K to 285 K. Given that the molar heat capacity of O2 at constant pressure is 29.4 J K−1 mol−1 , calculate q, ∆H, and ∆U. 2.13(b) When 2.0 mol CO2 is heated at a constant pressure of 1.25 atm, its temperature increases from 250 K to 277 K. Given that the molar heat capacity of CO2 at constant pressure is 37.11 J K−1 mol−1 , calculate q, ∆H, and ∆U. 2.14(a) A sample of 4.0 mol O2 is originally confined in 20 dm3 at 270 K and then undergoes adiabatic expansion against a constant pressure of 600 Torr until the volume has increased by a factor of 3.0. Calculate q, w, ∆T, ∆U, and ∆H. (The final pressure of the gas is not necessarily 600 Torr.) 2.14(b) A sample of 5.0 mol CO2 is originally confined in 15 dm3 at 280 K and then undergoes adiabatic expansion against a constant pressure of 78.5 kPa until the volume has increased by a factor of 4.0. Calculate q, w, ∆T, ∆U, and ∆H. (The final pressure of the gas is not necessarily 78.5 kPa.) 2.15(a) A sample consisting of 1.0 mol of perfect gas molecules with CV = 20.8 J K−1 is initially at 3.25 atm and 310 K. It undergoes reversible adiabatic expansion until its pressure reaches 2.50 atm. Calculate the final volume and temperature and the work done. 2.15(b) A sample consisting of 1.5 mol of perfect gas molecules with Cp,m = 20.8 J K−1 mol−1 is initially at 230 kPa and 315 K. It undergoes reversible adiabatic expansion until its pressure reaches 170 kPa. Calculate the final volume and temperature and the work done. 2.16(a) A certain liquid has ∆vapH7 = 26.0 kJ mol−1 . Calculate q, w, ∆H, and ∆U when 0.50 mol is vaporized at 250 K and 750 Torr. 2.16(b) A certain liquid has ∆vapH7 = 32.0 kJ mol−1 . Calculate q, w, ∆H, and ∆U when 0.75 mol is vaporized at 260 K and 765 Torr. 2.17(a) The standard enthalpy of formation of ethylbenzene is −12.5 kJ mol−1 . Calculate its standard enthalpy of combustion. 2.17(b) The standard enthalpy of formation of phenol is −165.0 kJ mol−1 . Calculate its standard enthalpy of combustion. 2.18(a) The standard enthalpy of combustion of cyclopropane is −2091 kJ mol−1 at 25°C. From this information and enthalpy of formation data for CO2(g) and H2O(g), calculate the enthalpy of formation of cyclopropane. The enthalpy of formation of propene is +20.42 kJ mol−1 . Calculate the enthalpy of isomerization of cyclopropane to propene. 2.18(b) From the following data, determine ∆fH7 for diborane, B2H6(g), at 298 K: (1) B2H6(g) + 3 O2(g) → B2O3(s) + 3 H2O(g) ∆rH7 = −1941 kJ mol−1 (2) 2 B(s) + 3 –2 O2(g) → B2O3(s) ∆rH7 = −2368 kJ mol−1 (3) H2(g) + 1 –2 O2(g) → H2O(g) ∆rH7 = −241.8 kJ mol−1 2.19(a) When 120 mg of naphthalene, C10H8(s), was burned in a bomb calorimeter the temperature rose by 3.05 K. Calculate the calorimeter constant. By how much will the temperature rise when 10 mg of phenol, C6H5OH(s), is burned in the calorimeter under the same conditions? 2.19(b) When 2.25 mg of anthracene, C14H10(s), was burned in a bomb calorimeter the temperature rose by 1.35 K. Calculate the calorimeter constant. By how much will the temperature rise when 135 mg of phenol, C6H5OH(s), is burned in the calorimeter under the same conditions? (∆cH7 (C14H10, s) = −7061 kJ mol−1 .) 2.20(a) Calculate the standard enthalpy of solution of AgCl(s) in water from the enthalpies of formation of the solid and the aqueous ions. 2.20(b) Calculate the standard enthalpy of solution of AgBr(s) in water from the enthalpies of formation of the solid and the aqueous ions. 2.21(a) The standard enthalpy of decomposition of the yellow complex H3NSO2 into NH3 and SO2 is +40 kJ mol−1 . Calculate the standard enthalpy of formation of H3NSO2. 2.21(b) Given that the standard enthalpy of combustion of graphite is −393.51 kJ mol−1 and that of diamond is −395.41 kJ mol−1 , calculate the enthalpy of the graphite-to-diamond transition. 2.22(a) Given the reactions (1) and (2) below, determine (a) ∆rH7 and ∆rU7 for reaction (3), (b) ∆fH7 for both HCl(g) and H2O(g) all at 298 K. (1) H2(g) + Cl2(g) → 2 HCl(g) ∆rH7 = −184.62 kJ mol−1 (2) 2 H2(g) + O2(g) → 2 H2O(g) ∆rH7 = −483.64 kJ mol−1 (3) 4 HCl(g) + O2(g) → Cl2(g) + 2 H2O(g) 72 2 THE FIRST LAW 2.22(b) Given the reactions (1) and (2) below, determine (a) ∆rH7 and ∆rU7 for reaction (3), (b) ∆fH7 for both HCl(g) and H2O(g) all at 298 K. (1) H2(g) + I2(s) → 2 HI(g) ∆rH7 = +52.96 kJ mol−1 (2) 2 H2(g) + O2(g) → 2 H2O(g) ∆rH7 = −483.64 kJ mol−1 (3) 4 HI(g) + O2(g) → 2 I2(s) + 2 H2O(g) 2.23(a) For the reaction C2H5OH(l) + 3 O2(g) → 2 CO2(g) + 3 H2O(g), ∆rU7 = −1373 kJ mol−1 at 298 K. Calculate ∆rH7 . 2.23(b) For the reaction 2 C6H5COOH(s) + 13 O2(g) → 12 CO2(g) + 6 H2O(g), ∆rU7 = −772.7 kJ mol−1 at 298 K. Calculate ∆rH7 . 2.24(a) Calculate the standard enthalpies of formation of (a) KClO3(s) from the enthalpy of formation of KCl, (b) NaHCO3(s) from the enthalpies of formation of CO2 and NaOH together with the following information: 2 KClO3(s) → 2 KCl(s) + 3 O2(g) ∆rH7 = −89.4 kJ mol−1 NaOH(s) + CO2(g) → NaHCO3(s) ∆rH7 = −127.5 kJ mol−1 2.24(b) Calculate the standard enthalpy of formation of NOCl(g) from the enthalpy of formation of NO given in Table 2.5, together with the following information: 2 NOCl(g) → 2 NO(g) + Cl2(g) ∆rH7 = +75.5 kJ mol−1 2.25(a) Use the information in Table 2.5 to predict the standard reaction enthalpy of 2 NO2(g) → N2O4(g) at 100°C from its value at 25°C. 2.25(b) Use the information in Table 2.5 to predict the standard reaction enthalpy of 2 H2(g) + O2(g) → 2 H2O(l) at 100°C from its value at 25°C. 2.26(a) From the data in Table 2.5, calculate ∆rH7 and ∆rU7 at (a) 298 K, (b) 378 K for the reaction C(graphite) + H2O(g) → CO(g) + H2(g). Assume all heat capacities to be constant over the temperature range of interest. 2.26(b) Calculate ∆rH7 and ∆rU7 at 298 K and ∆rH7 at 348 K for the hydrogenation of ethyne (acetylene) to ethene (ethylene) from the enthalpy of combustion and heat capacity data in Tables 2.5 and 2.7. Assume the heat capacities to be constant over the temperature range involved. 2.27(a) Calculate ∆rH7 for the reaction Zn(s) + CuSO4(aq) → ZnSO4(aq) + Cu(s) from the information in Table 2.7 in the Data section. 2.27(b) Calculate ∆rH7 for the reaction NaCl(aq) + AgNO3(aq) → AgCl(s) + NaNO3(aq) from the information in Table 2.7 in the Data section. 2.28(a) Set up a thermodynamic cycle for determining the enthalpy of hydration of Mg2+ ions using the following data: enthalpy of sublimation of Mg(s), +167.2 kJ mol−1 ; first and second ionization enthalpies of Mg(g), 7.646 eV and 15.035 eV; dissociation enthalpy of Cl2(g), +241.6 kJ mol−1 ; electron gain enthalpy of Cl(g), −3.78 eV; enthalpy of solution of MgCl2(s), −150.5 kJ mol−1 ; enthalpy of hydration of Cl− (g), −383.7 kJ mol−1 . 2.28(b) Set up a thermodynamic cycle for determining the enthalpy of hydration of Ca2+ ions using the following data: enthalpy of sublimation of Ca(s), +178.2 kJ mol−1 ; first and second ionization enthalpies of Ca(g), 589.7 kJ mol−1 and 1145 kJ mol−1 ; enthalpy of vaporization of bromine, +30.91 kJ mol−1 ; dissociation enthalpy of Br2(g), +192.9 kJ mol−1 ; electron gain enthalpy of Br(g), −331.0 kJ mol−1 ; enthalpy of solution of CaBr2(s), −103.1 kJ mol−1 ; enthalpy of hydration of Br− (g), −337 kJ mol−1 . 2.29(a) When a certain freon used in refrigeration was expanded adiabatically from an initial pressure of 32 atm and 0°C to a final pressure of 1.00 atm, the temperature fell by 22 K. Calculate the Joule–Thomson coefficient, µ, at 0°C, assuming it remains constant over this temperature range. 2.29(b) A vapour at 22 atm and 5°C was allowed to expand adiabatically to a final pressure of 1.00 atm; the temperature fell by 10 K. Calculate the Joule–Thomson coefficient, µ, at 5°C, assuming it remains constant over this temperature range. 2.30(a) For a van der Waals gas, πT = a/V2 m. Calculate ∆Um for the isothermal expansion of nitrogen gas from an initial volume of 1.00 dm3 to 24.8 dm3 at 298 K. What are the values of q and w? 2.30(b) Repeat Exercise 2.30(a) for argon, from an initial volume of 1.00 dm3 to 22.1 dm3 at 298 K. 2.31(a) The volume of a certain liquid varies with temperature as V = V′{0.75 + 3.9 × 10−4 (T/K) + 1.48 × 10−6 (T/K)2 } where V′ is its volume at 300 K. Calculate its expansion coefficient, α, at 320 K. 2.31(b) The volume of a certain liquid varies with temperature as V = V′{0.77 + 3.7 × 10−4 (T/K) + 1.52 × 10−6 (T/K)2 } where V′ is its volume at 298 K. Calculate its expansion coefficient, α, at 310 K. 2.32(a) The isothermal compressibility of copper at 293 K is 7.35 × 10−7 atm−1 . Calculate the pressure that must be applied in order to increase its density by 0.08 per cent. 2.32(b) The isothermal compressibility of lead at 293 K is 2.21 × 10−6 atm−1 . Calculate the pressure that must be applied in order to increase its density by 0.08 per cent. 2.33(a) Given that µ = 0.25 K atm−1 for nitrogen, calculate the value of its isothermal Joule–Thomson coefficient. Calculate the energy that must be supplied as heat to maintain constant temperature when 15.0 mol N2 flows through a throttle in an isothermal Joule–Thomson experiment and the pressure drop is 75 atm. 2.33(b) Given that µ = 1.11 K atm−1 for carbon dioxide, calculate the value of its isothermal Joule–Thomson coefficient. Calculate the energy that must be supplied as heat to maintain constant temperature when 12.0 mol CO2 flows through a throttle in an isothermal Joule–Thomson experiment and the pressure drop is 55 atm. PROBLEMS 73 Problems* Assume all gases are perfect unless stated otherwise. Note that 1 atm = 1.013 25 bar. Unless otherwise stated, thermochemical data are for 298.15 K. Numerical problems 2.1 A sample consisting of 1 mol of perfect gas atoms (for which CV,m = 3 –2R) is taken through the cycle shown in Fig. 2.34. (a) Determine the temperature at the points 1, 2, and 3. (b) Calculate q, w, ∆U, and ∆H for each step and for the overall cycle. If a numerical answer cannot be obtained from the information given, then write in +, −, 0, or ? as appropriate. 2.2 A sample consisting of 1.0 mol CaCO3(s) was heated to 800°C, when it decomposed. The heating was carried out in a container fitted with a piston that was initially resting on the solid. Calculate the work done during complete decomposition at 1.0 atm. What work would be done if instead of having a piston the container was open to the atmosphere? 2.3 A sample consisting of 2.0 mol CO2 occupies a fixed volume of 15.0 dm3 at 300 K. When it is supplied with 2.35 kJ of energy as heat its temperature increases to 341 K. Assume that CO2 is described by the van der Waals equation of state, and calculate w, ∆U, and ∆H. 2.4 A sample of 70 mmol Kr(g) expands reversibly and isothermally at 373 K from 5.25 cm3 to 6.29 cm3 , and the internal energy of the sample is known to increase by 83.5 J. Use the virial equation of state up to the second coefficient B = −28.7 cm3 mol−1 to calculate w, q, and ∆H for this change of state. 2.5 A sample of 1.00 mol perfect gas molecules with Cp,m = 7 –2R is put through the following cycle: (a) constant-volume heating to twice its initial volume, (b) reversible, adiabatic expansion back to its initial temperature, (c) reversible isothermal compression back to 1.00 atm. Calculate q, w, ∆U, and ∆H for each step and overall. 2.6 Calculate the work done during the isothermal reversible expansion of a van der Waals gas. Account physically for the way in which the coefficients a and b appear in the final expression. Plot on the same graph the indicator diagrams for the isothermal reversible expansion of (a) a perfect gas, (b) a van der Waals gas in which a = 0 and b = 5.11 × 10−2 dm3 mol−1 , and (c) a = 4.2 dm6 atm mol−2 and b = 0. The values selected exaggerate the imperfections but give rise to significant effects on the indicator diagrams. Take Vi = 1.0 dm3 , n = 1.0 mol, and T = 298 K. 2.7 The molar heat capacity of ethane is represented in the temperature range 298 K to 400 K by the empirical expression Cp,m/(J K−1 mol−1 ) = 14.73 + 0.1272(T/K). The corresponding expressions for C(s) and H2(g) are given in Fig. 2.34 Table 2.2. Calculate the standard enthalpy of formation of ethane at 350 K from its value at 298 K. 2.8 A sample of the sugar d-ribose (C5H10O5) of mass 0.727 g was placed in a calorimeter and then ignited in the presence of excess oxygen. The temperature rose by 0.910 K. In a separate experiment in the same calorimeter, the combustion of 0.825 g of benzoic acid, for which the internal energy of combustion is −3251 kJ mol−1 , gave a temperature rise of 1.940 K. Calculate the internal energy of combustion of d-ribose and its enthalpy of formation. 2.9 The standard enthalpy of formation of the metallocene bis(benzene)chromium was measured in a calorimeter. It was found for the reaction Cr(C6H6)2(s) → Cr(s) + 2 C6H6(g) that ∆rU7 (583 K) = +8.0 kJ mol−1 . Find the corresponding reaction enthalpy and estimate the standard enthalpy of formation of the compound at 583 K. The constant-pressure molar heat capacity of benzene is 136.1 J K−1 mol−1 in its liquid range and 81.67 J K−1 mol−1 as a gas. 2.10‡ From the enthalpy of combustion data in Table 2.5 for the alkanes methane through octane, test the extent to which the relation ∆cH7 = k{(M/(g mol−1 )}n holds and find the numerical values for k and n. Predict ∆cH7 for decane and compare to the known value. 2.11 It is possible to investigate the thermochemical properties of hydrocarbons with molecular modelling methods. (a) Use electronic structure software to predict ∆cH7 values for the alkanes methane through pentane. To calculate ∆cH7 values, estimate the standard enthalpy of formation of CnH2(n+1)(g) by performing semi-empirical calculations (for example, AM1 or PM3 methods) and use experimental standard enthalpy of formation values for CO2(g) and H2O(l). (b) Compare your estimated values with the experimental values of ∆cH7 (Table 2.5) and comment on the reliability of the molecular modelling method. (c) Test the extent to which the relation ∆cH7 = k{(M/(g mol−1 )}n holds and find the numerical values for k and n. 2.12‡ When 1.3584 g of sodium acetate trihydrate was mixed into 100.0 cm3 of 0.2000 m HCl(aq) at 25°C in a solution calorimeter, its temperature fell by 0.397°C on account of the reaction: H3O+ (aq) + NaCH3CO2 · 3 H2O(s) → Na+ (aq) + CH3COOH(aq) + 4 H2O(l). The heat capacity of the calorimeter is 91.0 J K−1 and the heat capacity density of the acid solution is 4.144 J K−1 cm−3 . Determine the standard enthalpy of formation of the aqueous sodium cation. The standard enthalpy of formation of sodium acetate trihydrate is −1064 kJ mol−1 . 2.13‡ Since their discovery in 1985, fullerenes have received the attention of many chemical researchers. Kolesov et al. reported the standard enthalpy of combustion and of formation of crystalline C60 based on calorimetric measurements (V.P. Kolesov, S.M. Pimenova, V.K. Pavlovich, N.B. Tamm, and A.A. Kurskaya, J. Chem. Thermodynamics 28, 1121 (1996)). In one of their runs, they found the standard specific internal energy of combustion to be −36.0334 kJ g−1 at 298.15 K Compute ∆cH7 and ∆fH7 of C60. 2.14‡ A thermodynamic study of DyCl3 (E.H.P. Cordfunke, A.S. Booji, and M. Yu. Furkaliouk, J. Chem. Thermodynamics 28, 1387 (1996)) determined its standard enthalpy of formation from the following information (1) DyCl3(s) → DyCl3(aq, in 4.0 m HCl) ∆rH7 = −180.06 kJ mol−1 (2) Dy(s) + 3 HCl(aq, 4.0 m) → DyCl3(aq, in 4.0 m HCl(aq)) + 3 –2 H2(g) ∆rH7 = −699.43 kJ mol−1 (3) 1 –2 H2(g) + 1 –2 Cl2(g) → HCl(aq, 4.0 m) ∆rH7 = −158.31 kJ mol−1 Determine ∆fH7 (DyCl3, s) from these data. * Problems denoted with the symbol ‡ were supplied by Charles Trapp, Carmen Giunta, and Marshall Cady. 74 2 THE FIRST LAW 2.15‡ Silylene (SiH2) is a key intermediate in the thermal decomposition of silicon hydrides such as silane (SiH4) and disilane (Si2H6). Moffat et al. (H.K. Moffat, K.F. Jensen, and R.W. Carr, J. Phys. Chem. 95, 145 (1991)) report ∆fH7 (SiH2) = +274 kJ mol−1 . If ∆fH7 (SiH4) = +34.3 kJ mol−1 and ∆fH7 (Si2H6) = +80.3 kJ mol−1 (CRC Handbook (2004)), compute the standard enthalpies of the following reactions: (a) SiH4(g) → SiH2(g) + H2(g) (b) Si2H6(g) → SiH2(g) + SiH4(g) 2.16‡ Silanone (SiH2O) and silanol (SiH3OH) are species believed to be important in the oxidation of silane (SiH4). These species are much more elusive than their carbon counterparts. C.L. Darling and H.B. Schlegel (J. Phys. Chem. 97, 8207 (1993)) report the following values (converted from calories) from a computational study: ∆fH7 (SiH2O) = −98.3 kJ mol−1 and ∆fH7 (SiH3OH) = −282 kJ mol−1 . Compute the standard enthalpies of the following reactions: (a) SiH4(g) + 1 –2 O2(g) → SiH3OH(g) (b) SiH4(g) + O2(g) → SiH2O(g) + H2O(l) (c) SiH3OH(g) → SiH2O(g) + H2(g) Note that ∆fH7 (SiH4, g) = +34.3 kJ mol−1 (CRC Handbook (2004)). 2.17 The constant-volume heat capacity of a gas can be measured by observing the decrease in temperature when it expands adiabatically and reversibly. If the decrease in pressure is also measured, we can use it to infer the value of γ = Cp/CV and hence, by combining the two values, deduce the constant-pressure heat capacity. A fluorocarbon gas was allowed to expand reversibly and adiabatically to twice its volume; as a result, the temperature fell from 298.15 K to 248.44 K and its pressure fell from 202.94 kPa to 81.840 kPa. Evaluate Cp. 2.18 A sample consisting of 1.00 mol of a van der Waals gas is compressed from 20.0 dm3 to 10.0 dm3 at 300 K. In the process, 20.2 kJ of work is done on the gas. Given that µ = {(2a/RT) − b}/Cp,m, with Cp,m = 38.4 J K−1 mol−1 , a = 3.60 dm6 atm mol−2 , and b = 0.44 dm3 mol−1 , calculate ∆H for the process. 2.19 Take nitrogen to be a van der Waals gas with a = 1.352 dm6 atm mol−2 and b = 0.0387 dm3 mol−1 , and calculate ∆Hm when the pressure on the gas is decreased from 500 atm to 1.00 atm at 300 K. For a van der Waals gas, µ = {(2a/RT) − b}/Cp,m. Assume Cp,m = 7 –2R. Theoretical problems 2.20 Show that the following functions have exact differentials: (a) x2 y + 3y2 , (b) x cos xy, (c) x3 y2 , (d) t(t + es ) + s. 2.21 (a) What is the total differential of z = x2 + 2y2 − 2xy + 2x − 4y − 8? (b) Show that ∂2 z/∂y∂x = ∂2 z/∂x∂y for this function. (c) Let z = xy − y + ln x + 2. Find dz and show that it is exact. 2.22 (a) Express (∂CV/∂V)T as a second derivative of U and find its relation to (∂U/∂V)T and (∂Cp/∂p)T as a second derivative of H and find its relation to (∂H/∂p)T. (b) From these relations show that (∂CV/∂V)T = 0 and (∂Cp/∂p)T = 0 for a perfect gas. 2.23 (a) Derive the relation CV = −(∂U/∂V)T(∂V/∂T)U from the expression for the total differential of U(T,V) and (b) starting from the expression for the total differential of H(T,p), express (∂H/∂p)T in terms of Cp and the Joule–Thomson coefficient, µ. 2.24 Starting from the expression Cp − CV = T(∂p/∂T)V(∂V/∂T)p, use the appropriate relations between partial derivatives to show that Cp − CV = Evaluate Cp − CV for a perfect gas. 2.25 (a) By direct differentiation of H = U + pV, obtain a relation between (∂H/∂U)p and (∂U/∂V)p. (b) Confirm that (∂H/∂U)p = 1 + p(∂V/∂U)p by T(∂V/∂T)2 p (∂V/∂T)T expressing (∂H/∂U)p as the ratio of two derivatives with respect to volume and then using the definition of enthalpy. 2.26 (a) Write expressions for dV and dp given that V is a function of p and T and p is a function of V and T. (b) Deduce expressions for d ln V and d ln p in terms of the expansion coefficient and the isothermal compressibility. 2.27 Calculate the work done during the isothermal reversible expansion of a gas that satisfies the virial equation of state, eqn 1.19. Evaluate (a) the work for 1.0 mol Ar at 273 K (for data, see Table 1.3) and (b) the same amount of a perfect gas. Let the expansion be from 500 cm3 to 1000 cm3 in each case. 2.28 Express the work of isothermal reversible expansion of a van der Waals gas in reduced variables and find a definition of reduced work that makes the overall expression independent of the identity of the gas. Calculate the work of isothermal reversible expansion along the critical isotherm from Vc to xVc. 2.29‡ A gas obeying the equation of state p(V − nb) = nRT is subjected to a Joule–Thomson expansion. Will the temperature increase, decrease, or remain the same? 2.30 Use the fact that (∂U/∂V)T = a/V2 m for a van der Waals gas to show that µCp,m ≈ (2a/RT) − b by using the definition of µ and appropriate relations between partial derivatives. (Hint. Use the approximation pVm ≈ RT when it is justifiable to do so.) 2.31 Rearrange the van der Waals equation of state to give an expression for T as a function of p and V (with n constant). Calculate (∂T/∂p)V and confirm that (∂T/∂p)V = 1/(∂p/∂T)V. Go on to confirm Euler’s chain relation. 2.32 Calculate the isothermal compressibility and the expansion coefficient of a van der Waals gas. Show, using Euler’s chain relation, that κTR = α(Vm − b). 2.33 Given that µCp = T(∂V/∂T)p − V, derive an expression for µ in terms of the van der Waals parameters a and b, and express it in terms of reduced variables. Evaluate µ at 25°C and 1.0 atm, when the molar volume of the gas is 24.6 dm3 mol−1 . Use the expression obtained to derive a formula for the inversion temperature of a van der Waals gas in terms of reduced variables, and evaluate it for the xenon sample. 2.34 The thermodynamic equation of state (∂U/∂V)T = T(∂p/∂T)V − p was quoted in the chapter. Derive its partner T = −T p + V from it and the general relations between partial differentials. 2.35 Show that for a van der Waals gas, Cp,m − CV,m = λR = 1 − and evaluate the difference for xenon at 25°C and 10.0 atm. 2.36 The speed of sound, cs, in a gas of molar mass M is related to the ratio of heat capacities γ by cs = (γRT/M)1/2 . Show that cs = (γp/ρ)1/2 , where ρ is the mass density of the gas. Calculate the speed of sound in argon at 25°C. 2.37‡ A gas obeys the equation of state Vm = RT/p + aT2 and its constantpressure heat capacity is given by Cp,m = A + BT + Cp, where a, A, B, and C are constants independent of T and p. Obtain expressions for (a) the Joule–Thomson coefficient and (b) its constant-volume heat capacity. Applications: to biology, materials science, and the environment 2.38 It is possible to see with the aid of a powerful microscope that a long piece of double-stranded DNA is flexible, with the distance between the ends of the chain adopting a wide range of values. This flexibility is important because it allows DNA to adopt very compact conformations as it is packaged in a chromosome (see Chapter 18). It is convenient to visualize a long piece (3Vr − 1)2 4V3 rTr 1 λ D E F ∂V ∂T A B C D E F ∂H ∂p A B C PROBLEMS 75 of DNA as a freely jointed chain, a chain of N small, rigid units of length l that are free to make any angle with respect to each other. The length l, the persistence length, is approximately 45 nm, corresponding to approximately 130 base pairs. You will now explore the work associated with extending a DNA molecule. (a) Suppose that a DNA molecule resists being extended from an equilibrium, more compact conformation with a restoring force F = −kFx, where x is the difference in the end-to-end distance of the chain from an equilibrium value and kF is the force constant. Systems showing this behaviour are said to obey Hooke’s law. (i) What are the limitations of this model of the DNA molecule? (ii) Using this model, write an expression for the work that must be done to extend a DNA molecule by x. Draw a graph of your conclusion. (b) A better model of a DNA molecule is the onedimensional freely jointed chain, in which a rigid unit of length l can only make an angle of 0° or 180° with an adjacent unit. In this case, the restoring force of a chain extended by x = nl is given by F = ln ν = n/N where k = 1.381 × 10−23 J K−1 is Boltzmann’s constant (not a force constant). (i) What are the limitations of this model? (ii) What is the magnitude of the force that must be applied to extend a DNA molecule with N = 200 by 90 nm? (iii) Plot the restoring force against ν, noting that ν can be either positive or negative. How is the variation of the restoring force with end-to-end distance different from that predicted by Hooke’s law? (iv) Keeping in mind that the difference in end-to-end distance from an equilibrium value is x = nl and, consequently, dx = ldn = Nldν, write an expression for the work of extending a DNA molecule. (v) Calculate the work of extending a DNA molecule from ν = 0 to ν = 1.0. Hint. You must integrate the expression for w. The task can be accomplished easily with mathematical software. (c) Show that for small extensions of the chain, when ν << 1, the restoring force is given by F ≈ = Hint. See Appendix 2 for a review of series expansions of functions. (d) Is the variation of the restoring force with extension of the chain given in part (c) different from that predicted by Hooke’s law? Explain your answer. 2.39 There are no dietary recommendations for consumption of carbohydrates. Some nutritionists recommend diets that are largely devoid of carbohydrates, with most of the energy needs being met by fats. However, the most common recommendation is that at least 65 per cent of our food calories should come from carbohydrates. A 3 –4-cup serving of pasta contains 40 g of carbohydrates. What percentage of the daily calorie requirement for a person on a 2200 Calorie diet (1 Cal = 1 kcal) does this serving represent? 2.40 An average human produces about 10 MJ of heat each day through metabolic activity. If a human body were an isolated system of mass 65 kg with the heat capacity of water, what temperature rise would the body experience? Human bodies are actually open systems, and the main mechanism of heat loss is through the evaporation of water. What mass of water should be evaporated each day to maintain constant temperature? 2.41 Glucose and fructose are simple sugars with the molecular formula C6H12O6. Sucrose, or table sugar, is a complex sugar with molecular formula C12H22O11 that consists of a glucose unit covalently bound to a fructose unit (a water molecule is given off as a result of the reaction between glucose and fructose to form sucrose). (a) Calculate the energy released as heat when a typical table sugar cube of mass 1.5 g is burned in air. (b) To what height could you climb on the energy a table sugar cube provides assuming 25 per cent of the energy is available for work? (c) The mass of a typical glucose tablet is 2.5 g. Calculate the energy released as heat when a glucose tablet is burned in air. (d) To what height could you climb on the energy a cube provides assuming 25 per cent of the energy is available for work? 2.42 In biological cells that have a plentiful supply of O2, glucose is oxidized completely to CO2 and H2O by a process called aerobic oxidation. Muscle cells may be deprived of O2 during vigorous exercise and, in that case, one nkT Nl νkT l D E F 1 + ν 1 − ν A B C kT 2l molecule of glucose is converted to two molecules of lactic acid (CH3CH(OH)COOH) by a process called anaerobic glycolysis (see Impact I7.2). (a) When 0.3212 g of glucose was burned in a bomb calorimeter of calorimeter constant 641 J K−1 the temperature rose by 7.793 K. Calculate (i) the standard molar enthalpy of combustion, (ii) the standard internal energy of combustion, and (iii) the standard enthalpy of formation of glucose. (b) What is the biological advantage (in kilojoules per mole of energy released as heat) of complete aerobic oxidation compared with anaerobic glycolysis to lactic acid? 2.43 You have at your disposal a sample of pure polymer P and a sample of P that has just been synthesized in a large chemical reactor and that may contain impurities. Describe how you would use differential scanning calorimetry to determine the mole percentage composition of P in the allegedly impure sample. 2.44‡ Alkyl radicals are important intermediates in the combustion and atmospheric chemistry of hydrocarbons. Seakins et al. (P.W. Seakins, M.J. Pilling, J.T. Niiranen, D. Gutman, and L.N. Krasnoperov, J. Phys. Chem. 96, 9847 (1992)) report ∆fH7 for a variety of alkyl radicals in the gas phase, information that is applicable to studies of pyrolysis and oxidation reactions of hydrocarbons. This information can be combined with thermodynamic data on alkenes to determine the reaction enthalpy for possible fragmentation of a large alkyl radical into smaller radicals and alkenes. Use the following set of data to compute the standard reaction enthalpies for three possible fates of the tert-butyl radical, namely, (a) tert-C4H9 → sec-C4H9, (b) tert-C4H9 → C3H6 + CH3, (c) tert-C4H9 → C2H4 + C2H5. Species: C2H5 sec-C4H9 tert-C4H9 ∆fH7 /(kJ mol−1 ) +121.0 +67.5 +51.3 2.45‡ In 1995, the Intergovernmental Panel on Climate Change (IPCC) considered a global average temperature rise of 1.0–3.5°C likely by the year 2100, with 2.0°C its best estimate. Predict the average rise in sea level due to thermal expansion of sea water based on temperature rises of 1.0°C, 2.0°C, and 3.5°C given that the volume of the Earth’s oceans is 1.37 × 109 km3 and their surface area is 361 × 106 km2 , and state the approximations that go into the estimates. 2.46‡ Concerns over the harmful effects of chlorofluorocarbons on stratospheric ozone have motivated a search for new refrigerants. One such alternative is 2,2-dichloro-1,1,1-trifluoroethane (refrigerant 123). Younglove and McLinden published a compendium of thermophysical properties of this substance (B.A. Younglove and M. McLinden, J. Phys. Chem. Ref. Data 23, 7 (1994)), from which properties such as the Joule–Thomson coefficient µ can be computed. (a) Compute µ at 1.00 bar and 50°C given that (∂H/∂p)T = −3.29 × 103 J MPa−1 mol−1 and Cp,m = 110.0 J K−1 mol−1 . (b) Compute the temperature change that would accompany adiabatic expansion of 2.0 mol of this refrigerant from 1.5 bar to 0.5 bar at 50°C. 2.47‡ Another alternative refrigerant (see preceding problem) is 1,1,1,2tetrafluoroethane (refrigerant HFC-134a). Tillner-Roth and Baehr published a compendium of thermophysical properties of this substance (R. TillnerRoth and H.D. Baehr, J. Phys. Chem. Ref. Data 23, 657 (1994)), from which properties such as the Joule–Thomson coefficient µ can be computed. (a) Compute µ at 0.100 MPa and 300 K from the following data (all referring to 300 K): p/MPa 0.080 0.100 0.12 Specific enthalpy/(kJ kg−1 ) 426.48 426.12 425.76 (The specific constant-pressure heat capacity is 0.7649 kJ K−1 kg−1 .) (b) Compute µ at 1.00 MPa and 350 K from the following data (all referring to 350 K): p/MPa 0.80 1.00 1.2 Specific enthalpy/(kJ kg−1 ) 461.93 459.12 456.15 (The specific constant-pressure heat capacity is 1.0392 kJ K−1 kg−1 .) The Second Law The purpose of this chapter is to explain the origin of the spontaneity of physical and chemical change. We examine two simple processes and show how to define, measure, and use a property, the entropy, to discuss spontaneous changes quantitatively. The chapter also introduces a major subsidiary thermodynamic property, the Gibbs energy, which lets us express the spontaneity of a process in terms of the properties of a system. The Gibbs energy also enables us to predict the maximum non-expansion work that a process can do. As we began to see in Chapter 2, one application of thermodynamics is to find relations between properties that might not be thought to be related. Several relations of this kind can be established by making use of the fact that the Gibbs energy is a state function. We also see how to derive expressions for the variation of the Gibbs energy with temperature and pressure and how to formulate expressions that are valid for real gases. These expressions will prove useful later when we discuss the effect of temperature and pressure on equilibrium constants. Some things happen naturally; some things don’t. A gas expands to fill the available volume, a hot body cools to the temperature of its surroundings, and a chemical reaction runs in one direction rather than another. Some aspect of the world determines the spontaneous direction of change, the direction of change that does not require work to be done to bring it about. A gas can be confined to a smaller volume, an object can be cooled by using a refrigerator, and some reactions can be driven in reverse (as in the electrolysis of water). However, none of these processes is spontaneous; each one must be brought about by doing work. An important point, though, is that throughout this text ‘spontaneous’ must be interpreted as a natural tendency that may or may not be realized in practice. Thermodynamics is silent on the rate at which a spontaneous change in fact occurs, and some spontaneous processes (such as the conversion of diamond to graphite) may be so slow that the tendency is never realized in practice whereas others (such as the expansion of a gas into a vacuum) are almost instantaneous. The recognition of two classes of process, spontaneous and non-spontaneous, is summarized by the Second Law of thermodynamics. This law may be expressed in a variety of equivalent ways. One statement was formulated by Kelvin: No process is possible in which the sole result is the absorption of heat from a reservoir and its complete conversion into work. For example, it has proved impossible to construct an engine like that shown in Fig. 3.1, in which heat is drawn from a hot reservoir and completely converted into work. All real heat engines have both a hot source and a cold sink; some energy is always discarded into the cold sink as heat and not converted into work. The Kelvin The direction of spontaneous change 3.1 The dispersal of energy 3.2 Entropy I3.1 Impact on engineering: Refrigeration 3.3 Entropy changes accompanying specific processes 3.4 The Third Law of thermodynamics Concentrating on the system 3.5 The Helmholtz and Gibbs energies 3.6 Standard reaction Gibbs energies Combining the First and Second Laws 3.7 The fundamental equation 3.8 Properties of the internal energy 3.9 Properties of the Gibbs energy Checklist of key ideas Further reading Further information 3.1: The Born equation Further information 3.2: Real gases: the fugacity Discussion questions Exercises Problems 3 3.1 THE DISPERSAL OF ENERGY 77 statement is a generalization of another everyday observation, that a ball at rest on a surface has never been observed to leap spontaneously upwards. An upward leap of the ball would be equivalent to the conversion of heat from the surface into work. The direction of spontaneous change What determines the direction of spontaneous change? It is not the total energy of the isolated system. The First Law of thermodynamics states that energy is conserved in any process, and we cannot disregard that law now and say that everything tends towards a state of lower energy: the total energy of an isolated system is constant. Is it perhaps the energy of the system that tends towards a minimum? Two arguments show that this cannot be so. First, a perfect gas expands spontaneously into a vacuum, yet its internal energy remains constant as it does so. Secondly, if the energy of a system does happen to decrease during a spontaneous change, the energy of its surroundings must increase by the same amount (by the First Law). The increase in energy of the surroundings is just as spontaneous a process as the decrease in energy of the system. When a change occurs, the total energy of an isolated system remains constant but it is parcelled out in different ways. Can it be, therefore, that the direction of change is related to the distribution of energy? We shall see that this idea is the key, and that spontaneous changes are always accompanied by a dispersal of energy. 3.1 The dispersal of energy We can begin to understand the role of the distribution of energy by thinking about a ball (the system) bouncing on a floor (the surroundings). The ball does not rise as high after each bounce because there are inelastic losses in the materials of the ball and floor. The kinetic energy of the ball’s overall motion is spread out into the energy of thermal motion of its particles and those of the floor that it hits. The direction of spontaneous change is towards a state in which the ball is at rest with all its energy dispersed into random thermal motion of molecules in the air and of the atoms of the virtually infinite floor (Fig. 3.2). A ball resting on a warm floor has never been observed to start bouncing. For bouncing to begin, something rather special would need to happen. In the first place, some of the thermal motion of the atoms in the floor would have to accumulate in a single, small object, the ball. This accumulation requires a spontaneous localization of energy from the myriad vibrations of the atoms of the floor into the much smaller number of atoms that constitute the ball (Fig. 3.3). Furthermore, whereas the thermal motion is random, for the ball to move upwards its atoms must all move in the same direction. The localization of random, disorderly motion as concerted, ordered motion is so unlikely that we can dismiss it as virtually impossible.1 We appear to have found the signpost of spontaneous change: we look for the direction of change that leads to dispersal of the total energy of the isolated system. This principle accounts for the direction of change of the bouncing ball, because its energy is spread out as thermal motion of the atoms of the floor. The reverse process is not spontaneous because it is highly improbable that energy will become localized, leading to uniform motion of the ball’s atoms. A gas does not contract spontaneously because Hot source Flow of energy Engine Heat Work Fig. 3.1 The Kelvin statement of the Second Law denies the possibility of the process illustrated here, in which heat is changed completely into work, there being no other change. The process is not in conflict with the First Law because energy is conserved. Fig. 3.2 The direction of spontaneous change for a ball bouncing on a floor. On each bounce some of its energy is degraded into the thermal motion of the atoms of the floor, and that energy disperses. The reverse has never been observed to take place on a macroscopic scale. 1 Concerted motion, but on a much smaller scale, is observed as Brownian motion, the jittering motion of small particles suspended in water. 78 3 THE SECOND LAW to do so the random motion of its molecules, which spreads out the distribution of kinetic energy throughout the container, would have to take them all into the same region of the container, thereby localizing the energy. The opposite change, spontaneous expansion, is a natural consequence of energy becoming more dispersed as the gas molecules occupy a larger volume. An object does not spontaneously become warmer than its surroundings because it is highly improbable that the jostling of randomly vibrating atoms in the surroundings will lead to the localization of thermal motion in the object. The opposite change, the spreading of the object’s energy into the surroundings as thermal motion, is natural. It may seem very puzzling that the spreading out of energy and matter, the collapse into disorder, can lead to the formation of such ordered structures as crystals or proteins. Nevertheless, in due course, we shall see that dispersal of energy and matter accounts for change in all its forms. 3.2 Entropy The First Law of thermodynamics led to the introduction of the internal energy, U. The internal energy is a state function that lets us assess whether a change is permissible: only those changes may occur for which the internal energy of an isolated system remains constant. The law that is used to identify the signpost of spontaneous change, the Second Law of thermodynamics, may also be expressed in terms of another state function, the entropy, S. We shall see that the entropy (which we shall define shortly, but is a measure of the energy dispersed in a process) lets us assess whether one state is accessible from another by a spontaneous change. The First Law uses the internal energy to identify permissible changes; the Second Law uses the entropy to identify the spontaneous changes among those permissible changes. The Second Law of thermodynamics can be expressed in terms of the entropy: The entropy of an isolated system increases in the course of a spontaneous change: ∆Stot > 0 where Stot is the total entropy of the system and its surroundings. Thermodynamically irreversible processes (like cooling to the temperature of the surroundings and the free expansion of gases) are spontaneous processes, and hence must be accompanied by an increase in total entropy. (a) The thermodynamic definition of entropy The thermodynamic definition of entropy concentrates on the change in entropy, dS, that occurs as a result of a physical or chemical change (in general, as a result of a ‘process’). The definition is motivated by the idea that a change in the extent to which energy is dispersed depends on how much energy is transferred as heat. As we have remarked, heat stimulates random motion in the surroundings. On the other hand, work stimulates uniform motion of atoms in the surroundings and so does not change their entropy. The thermodynamic definition of entropy is based on the expression dS = [3.1] For a measurable change between two states i and f this expression integrates to ∆S = Ύ f i (3.2) dqrev T dqrev T (a) (b) Fig. 3.3 The molecular interpretation of the irreversibility expressed by the Second Law. (a) A ball resting on a warm surface; the atoms are undergoing thermal motion (vibration, in this instance), as indicated by the arrows. (b) For the ball to fly upwards, some of the random vibrational motion would have to change into coordinated, directed motion. Such a conversion is highly improbable. 3.2 ENTROPY 79 2 The units of entropy are the same as those of the gas constant, R, and molar heat capacities. That is, to calculate the difference in entropy between any two states of a system, we find a reversible path between them, and integrate the energy supplied as heat at each stage of the path divided by the temperature at which heating occurs. Example 3.1 Calculating the entropy change for the isothermal expansion of a perfect gas Calculate the entropy change of a sample of perfect gas when it expands isothermally from a volume Vi to a volume Vf. Method The definition of entropy instructs us to find the energy supplied as heat for a reversible path between the stated initial and final states regardless of the actual manner in which the process takes place. A simplification is that the expansion is isothermal, so the temperature is a constant and may be taken outside the integral in eqn 3.2. The energy absorbed as heat during a reversible isothermal expansion of a perfect gas can be calculated from ∆U = q + w and ∆U = 0, which implies that q = −w in general and therefore that qrev = −wrev for a reversible change. The work of reversible isothermal expansion was calculated in Section 2.3. Answer Because the temperature is constant, eqn 3.2 becomes ∆S = Ύ f i dqrev = From eqn 2.11, we know that qrev = −wrev = nRT ln It follows that ∆S = nR ln As an illustration of this formula, when the volume occupied by 1.00 mol of any perfect gas molecules is doubled at any constant temperature, Vf/Vi = 2 and ∆S = (1.00 mol) × (8.3145 J K−1 mol−1 ) × ln 2 = +5.76 J K−1 A note on good practice According to eqn 3.2, when the energy transferred as heat is expressed in joules and the temperature is in kelvins, the units of entropy are joules per kelvin (J K−1 ). Entropy is an extensive property. Molar entropy, the entropy divided by the amount of substance, is expressed in joules per kelvin per mole (J K−1 mol−1 ).2 The molar entropy is an intensive property. Self-test 3.1 Calculate the change in entropy when the pressure of a perfect gas is changed isothermally from pi to pf. [∆S = nR ln(pi/pf)] We can use the definition in eqn 3.1 to formulate an expression for the change in entropy of the surroundings, ∆Ssur. Consider an infinitesimal transfer of heat dqsur to the surroundings. The surroundings consist of a reservoir of constant volume, so the energy supplied to them by heating can be identified with the change in their Vf Vi Vf Vi qrev T 1 T 80 3 THE SECOND LAW 3 Alternatively, the surroundings can be regarded as being at constant pressure, in which case we could equate dqsur to dHsur. internal energy, dUsur.3 The internal energy is a state function, and dUsur is an exact differential. As we have seen, these properties imply that dUsur is independent of how the change is brought about and in particular is independent of whether the process is reversible or irreversible. The same remarks therefore apply to dqsur, to which dUsur is equal. Therefore, we can adapt the definition in eqn 3.1 to write dSsur = = (3.3a) Furthermore, because the temperature of the surroundings is constant whatever the change, for a measurable change ∆Ssur = (3.3b) That is, regardless of how the change is brought about in the system, reversibly or irreversibly, we can calculate the change of entropy of the surroundings by dividing the heat transferred by the temperature at which the transfer takes place. Equation3.3makesitverysimpletocalculatethechangesinentropyofthesurroundings that accompany any process. For instance, for any adiabatic change, qsur = 0, so For an adiabatic change: ∆Ssur = 0 (3.4) This expression is true however the change takes place, reversibly or irreversibly, provided no local hot spots are formed in the surroundings. That is, it is true so long as the surroundings remain in internal equilibrium. If hot spots do form, then the localized energy may subsequently disperse spontaneously and hence generate more entropy. Illustration 3.1 Calculating the entropy change in the surroundings To calculate the entropy change in the surroundings when 1.00 mol H2O(l) is formed from its elements under standard conditions at 298 K, we use ∆H7 = −286 kJ from Table 2.7. The energy released as heat is supplied to the surroundings, now regarded as being at constant pressure, so qsur = +286 kJ. Therefore, ∆Ssur = = +960 J K−1 This strongly exothermic reaction results in an increase in the entropy of the surroundings as energy is released as heat into them. Self-test 3.2 Calculate the entropy change in the surroundings when 1.00 mol N2O4(g) is formed from 2.00 mol NO2(g) under standard conditions at 298 K. [−192 J K−1 ] Molecular interpretation 3.1 The statistical view of entropy The entry point into the molecular interpretation of the Second Law of thermodynamics is the realization that an atom or molecule can possess only certain energies, called its ‘energy levels’. The continuous thermal agitation that molecules 2.86 × 105 J 298 K qsur Tsur dqsur Tsur dqsur,rev Tsur 3.2 ENTROPY 81 (a) (b) Energy Population Fig. 3.4 The Boltzmann distribution predicts that the population of a state decreases exponentially with the energy of the state. (a) At low temperatures, only the lowest states are significantly populated; (b) at high temperatures, there is significant population in high-energy states as well as in low-energy states. At infinite temperature (not shown), all states are equally populated. experience in a sample at T > 0 ensures that they are distributed over the available energy levels. One particular molecule may be in one low energy state at one instant, and then be excited into a high energy state a moment later. Although we cannot keep track of the energy state of a single molecule, we can speak of the population of the state, the average number of molecules in each state; these populations are constant in time provided the temperature remains the same. Only the lowest energy state is occupied at T = 0. Raising the temperature excites some molecules into higher energy states, and more and more states become accessible as the temperature is raised further (Fig. 3.4). Nevertheless, whatever the temperature, there is always a higher population in a state of low energy than one of high energy. The only exception occurs when the temperature is infinite: then all states of the system are equally populated. These remarks were summarized quantitatively by the Austrian physicist Ludwig Boltzmann in the Boltzmann distribution: Ni = where k = 1.381 × 10−23 J K−1 and Ni is the number of molecules in a sample of N molecules that will be found in a state with an energy Ei when it is part of a system in thermal equilibrium at a temperature T. Care must be taken with the exact interpretation, though, because more than one state may correspond to the same energy: that is, an energy level may consist of several states. Boltzmann also made the link between the distribution of molecules over energy levels and the entropy. He proposed that the entropy of a system is given by S = k ln W (3.5) where W is the number of microstates, the ways in which the molecules of a system can be arranged while keeping the total energy constant. Each microstate lasts only for an instant and has a distinct distribution of molecules over the available energy levels. When we measure the properties of a system, we are measuring an average taken over the many microstates the system can occupy under the conditions of the experiment. The concept of the number of microstates makes quantitative the ill-defined qualitative concepts of ‘disorder’ and ‘the dispersal of matter and energy’ that are used widely to introduce the concept of entropy: a more ‘disorderly’ distribution of energy and matter corresponds to a greater number of microstates associated with the same total energy. Equation 3.5 is known as the Boltzmann formula and the entropy calculated from it is sometimes called the statistical entropy. We see that if W = 1, which corresponds to one microstate (only one way of achieving a given energy, all molecules in exactly the same state), then S = 0 because ln 1 = 0. However, if the system can exist in more than one microstate, then W > 1 and S > 0. But, if more molecules can participate in the distribution of energy, then there are more microstates for a given total energy and the entropy is greater than when the energy is confined so a smaller number of molecules. Therefore, the statistical view of entropy summarized by the Boltzmann formula is consistent with our previous statement that the entropy is related to the dispersal of energy. The molecular interpretation of entropy advanced by Boltzmann also suggests the thermodynamic definition given by eqn 3.1. To appreciate this point, consider that molecules in a system at high temperature can occupy a large number of the available energy levels, so a small additional transfer of energy as heat will lead to a relatively small change in the number of accessible energy levels. Consequently, the Ne−Ei/kT ∑ i e−Ei/kT 82 3 THE SECOND LAW Volume, V Pressure,p Initial state Final state Fig. 3.5 In a thermodynamic cycle, the overall change in a state function (from the initial state to the final state and then back to the initial state again) is zero. Volume, V Pressure,p 1 2 3 4 Isotherm Adiabat AdiabatTh Tc A B C D Fig. 3.6 The basic structure of a Carnot cycle. In Step 1, there is isothermal reversible expansion at the temperature Th. Step 2 is a reversible adiabatic expansion in which the temperature falls from Th to Tc. In Step 3 there is an isothermal reversible compression at Tc, and that isothermal step is followed by an adiabatic reversible compression, which restores the system to its initial state. number of microstates does not increase appreciably and neither does the entropy of the system. In contrast, the molecules in a system at low temperature have access to far fewer energy levels (at T = 0, only the lowest level is accessible), and the transfer of the same quantity of energy by heating will increase the number of accessible energy levels and the number of microstates rather significantly. Hence, the change in entropy upon heating will be greater when the energy is transferred to a cold body than when it is transferred to a hot body. This argument suggests that the change in entropy should be inversely proportional to the temperature at which the transfer takes place, as in eqn 3.1. (b) The entropy as a state function Entropy is a state function. To prove this assertion, we need to show that the integral of dS is independent of path. To do so, it is sufficient to prove that the integral of eqn 3.1 around an arbitrary cycle is zero, for that guarantees that the entropy is the same at the initial and final states of the system regardless of the path taken between them (Fig. 3.5). That is, we need to show that Ώ = 0 (3.6) where the symbol Ώ denotes integration around a closed path. There are three steps in the argument: 1. First, to show that eqn 3.6 is true for a special cycle (a ‘Carnot cycle’) involving a perfect gas. 2. Then to show that the result is true whatever the working substance. 3. Finally, to show that the result is true for any cycle. A Carnot cycle, which is named after the French engineer Sadi Carnot, consists of four reversible stages (Fig. 3.6): 1. Reversible isothermal expansion from A to B at Th; the entropy change is qh/Th, where qh is the energy supplied to the system as heat from the hot source. 2. Reversible adiabatic expansion from B to C. No energy leaves the system as heat, so the change in entropy is zero. In the course of this expansion, the temperature falls from Th to Tc, the temperature of the cold sink. 3. Reversible isothermal compression from C to D at Tc. Energy is released as heat to the cold sink; the change in entropy of the system is qc/Tc; in this expression qc is negative. 4. Reversible adiabatic compression from D to A. No energy enters the system as heat, so the change in entropy is zero. The temperature rises from Tc to Th. The total change in entropy around the cycle is ΏdS = + However, we show in Justification 3.1 that, for a perfect gas: = − (3.7)rev Substitution of this relation into the preceding equation gives zero on the right, which is what we wanted to prove. Th Tc qh qc qc Tc qh Th dqrev T 3.2 ENTROPY 83 Justification 3.1 Heating accompanying reversible adiabatic expansion This Justification is based on the fact that the two temperatures in eqn 3.7 lie on the same adiabat in Fig. 3.6. As explained in Example 3.1, for a perfect gas: qh = nRTh ln qc = nRTc ln From the relations between temperature and volume for reversible adiabatic processes (eqn 2.28): VATh c = VDTc c VcTc c = VBTh c Multiplication of the first of these expressions by the second gives VAVcTh c Tc c = VDVBTh c Tc c which simplifies to = Consequently, qc = nRTc ln = nRTc ln = −nRTc ln and therefore = = − as in eqn 3.7. In the second step we need to show that eqn 3.7 applies to any material, not just a perfect gas (which is why, in anticipation, we have not labelled it with a °). We begin this step of the argument by introducing the efficiency, ε (epsilon), of a heat engine: ε = = [3.8] The definition implies that, the greater the work output for a given supply of heat from the hot reservoir, the greater is the efficiency of the engine. We can express the definition in terms of the heat transactions alone, because (as shown in Fig. 3.7) the energy supplied as work by the engine is the difference between the energy supplied as heat by the hot reservoir and returned to the cold reservoir: ε = = 1 + (3.9) (Remember that qc < 0.) It then follows from eqn 3.7 that εrev = 1 − (3.10)rev Now we are ready to generalize this conclusion. The Second Law of thermodynamics implies that all reversible engines have the same efficiency regardless of their construction. To see the truth of this statement, suppose two reversible engines are coupled together and run between the same two reservoirs (Fig. 3.8). The working substances and details of construction of the two engines are entirely arbitrary. Initially, suppose that Tc Th qc qh qh + qc qh |w| qh work performed heat absorbed Th Tc nRTh ln(VB/VA) −nRTc ln(VB/VA) qh qc VB VA VA VB VD VC VD VC VA VB VD VC VB VA Tc Th qh qc | |w Hot source Cold sink +20 -15 5 Fig. 3.7 Suppose an energy qh (for example, 20 kJ) is supplied to the engine and qc is lost from the engine (for example, qc = −15 kJ) and discarded into the cold reservoir. The work done by the engine is equal to qh + qc (for example, 20 kJ + (−15 kJ) = 5 kJ). The efficiency is the work done divided by the energy supplied as heat from the hot source. 84 3 THE SECOND LAW engine A is more efficient than engine B and that we choose a setting of the controls that causes engine B to acquire energy as heat qc from the cold reservoir and to release a certain quantity of energy as heat into the hot reservoir. However, because engine A is more efficient than engine B, not all the work that A produces is needed for this process, and the difference can be used to do work. The net result is that the cold reservoir is unchanged, work has been done, and the hot reservoir has lost a certain amount of energy. This outcome is contrary to the Kelvin statement of the Second Law, because some heat has been converted directly into work. In molecular terms, the random thermal motion of the hot reservoir has been converted into ordered motion characteristic of work. Because the conclusion is contrary to experience, the initial assumption that engines A and B can have different efficiencies must be false. It follows that the relation between the heat transfers and the temperatures must also be independent of the working material, and therefore that eqn 3.7 is always true for any substance involved in a Carnot cycle. For the final step in the argument, we note that any reversible cycle can be approximated as a collection of Carnot cycles and the cyclic integral around an arbitrary path is the sum of the integrals around each of the Carnot cycles (Fig. 3.9). This approximation becomes exact as the individual cycles are allowed to become infinitesimal. The entropy change around each individual cycle is zero (as demonstrated above), so the sum of entropy changes for all the cycles is zero. However, in the sum, the entropy change along any individual path is cancelled by the entropy change along the path it shares with the neighbouring cycle. Therefore, all the entropy changes cancel except for those along the perimeter of the overall cycle. That is, ∑ all = ∑ perimeter = 0 qrev T qrev T Tc Th qh qh´ qc qc Hot source Hot source Cold sink (a) (b) q q´- w´ w´ A B Fig. 3.8 (a) The demonstration of the equivalence of the efficiencies of all reversible engines working between the same thermal reservoirs is based on the flow of energy represented in this diagram. (b) The net effect of the processes is the conversion of heat into work without there being a need for a cold sink: this is contrary to the Kelvin statement of the Second Law. Volume, V Pressure,p Cancel Survive Fig. 3.9 A general cycle can be divided into small Carnot cycles. The match is exact in the limit of infinitesimally small cycles. Paths cancel in the interior of the collection, and only the perimeter, an increasingly good approximation to the true cycle as the number of cycles increases, survives. Because the entropy change around every individual cycle is zero, the integral of the entropy around the perimeter is zero too. 3.2 ENTROPY 85 In the limit of infinitesimal cycles, the non-cancelling edges of the Carnot cycles match the overall cycle exactly, and the sum becomes an integral. Equation 3.6 then follows immediately. This result implies that dS is an exact differential and therefore that S is a state function. IMPACT ON ENGINEERING I3.1 Refrigeration The discussion of the text is the basis of the thermodynamic assessment of the power needed to cool objects in refrigerators. First, we consider the work required to cool an object, and refer to Fig. 3.10. When an energy |qc| is removed from a cool source at a temperature Tc and then deposited in a warmer sink at a temperature Th, as in a typical refrigerator, the change in entropy is ∆S = − + < 0 The process is not spontaneous because not enough entropy is generated in the warm sink to overcome the entropy loss from the hot source. To generate more entropy, energy must be added to the stream that enters the warm sink. Our task is to find the minimum energy that needs to be supplied. The outcome is expressed as the coefficient of performance, c: c = = The less the work that is required to achieve a given transfer, the greater the coefficient of performance and the more efficient the refrigerator. Because |qc| is removed from the cold source, and the work |w| is added to the energy stream, the energy deposited as heat in the hot sink is |qh| = |qc| + |w|. Therefore, = = − − 1 We can now use eqn 3.7 to express this result in terms of the temperatures alone, which is possible if the transfer is performed reversibly. This substitution leads to c = for the thermodynamically optimum coefficient of performance. For a refrigerator withdrawing heat from ice-cold water (Tc = 273 K) in a typical environment (Th = 293 K), c = 14, so, to remove 10 kJ (enough to freeze 30 g of water), requires transfer of at least 0.71 kJ as work. Practical refrigerators, of course, have a lower coefficient of performance. The work to maintain a low temperature is also relevant to the design of refrigerators. No thermal insulation is perfect, so there is always a flow of energy as heat into the sample at a rate proportional to the temperature difference. If the rate at which energy leaks in is written A(Th − Tc), where A is a constant that depends on the size of the sample and the details of the insulation, then the minimum power, P, required to maintain the original temperature difference by pumping out that energy by heating the surroundings is P = × A(Th − Tc) = A × (Th − Tc)2 Tc 1 c Tc Th − Tc |qh| |qc| |qh| − |qc| |qc| 1 c |qc| |w| energy transferred as heat energy transferred as work |qc| Th |qc| Tc Hot sink Cold source Th Tc Entropy change qc (a) Cold source Tc Hot sink Th qc w (b) Entropy change Fig. 3.10 (a) The flow of energy as heat from a cold source to a hot sink is not spontaneous. As shown here, the entropy increase of the hot sink is smaller than the entropy increase of the cold source, so there is a net decrease in entropy. (b) The process becomes feasible if work is provided to add to the energy stream. Then the increase in entropy of the hot sink can be made to cancel the entropy decrease of the hot source. 86 3 THE SECOND LAW Hot sourceTh Tc Cold sink |d |q d |d |/S q T= - h d |d |/S q T= + c Fig. 3.11 When energy leaves a hot reservoir as heat, the entropy of the reservoir decreases. When the same quantity of energy enters a cooler reservoir, the entropy increases by a larger amount. Hence, overall there is an increase in entropy and the process is spontaneous. Relative changes in entropy are indicated by the sizes of the arrows. We see that the power increases as the square of the temperature difference we are trying to maintain. For this reason, air-conditioners are much more expensive to run on hot days than on mild days. (c) The thermodynamic temperature Suppose we have an engine that is working reversibly between a hot source at a temperature Th and a cold sink at a temperature T; then we know from eqn 3.10 that T = (1 − ε)Th (3.11) This expression enabled Kelvin to define the thermodynamic temperature scale in terms of the efficiency of a heat engine. The zero of the scale occurs for a Carnot efficiency of 1. The size of the unit is entirely arbitrary, but on the Kelvin scale is defined by setting the temperature of the triple point of water as 273.16 K exactly. Then, if the heat engine has a hot source at the triple point of water, the temperature of the cold sink (the object we want to measure) is found by measuring the efficiency of the engine. This result is independent of the working substance. (d) The Clausius inequality We now show that the definition of entropy is consistent with the Second Law. To begin, we recall that more energy flows as work under reversible conditions than under irreversible conditions. That is, −dwrev ≥ −dw, or dw − dwrev ≥ 0. Because the internal energy is a state function, its change is the same for irreversible and reversible paths between the same two states, so we can also write: dU = dq + dw = dqrev + dwrev It follows that dqrev − dq = dw − dwrev ≥ 0, or dqrev ≥ dq, and therefore that dqrev/T ≥ dq/T. Now we use the thermodynamic definition of the entropy (eqn 3.1; dS = dqrev/T) to write dS ≥ (3.12) This expression is the Clausius inequality. It will prove to be of great importance for the discussion of the spontaneity of chemical reactions, as we shall see in Section 3.5. Illustration 3.2 Spontaneous cooling Consider the transfer of energy as heat from one system—the hot source—at a temperature Th to another system—the cold sink—at a temperature Tc (Fig. 3.11). When |dq| leaves the hot source (so dqh < 0), the Clausius inequality implies that dS ≥ dqh/Th. When |dq| enters the cold sink the Clausius inequality implies that dS ≥ dqc/Tc (with dqc > 0). Overall, therefore, dS ≥ + However, dqh = −dqc, so dS ≥ − + = dqc − which is positive (because dqc > 0 and Th ≥ Tc). Hence, cooling (the transfer of heat from hot to cold) is spontaneous, as we know from experience. D F 1 Th 1 Tc A C dqc Tc dqc Th dqc Tc dqh Th dq T Comment 3.1 The triple point of a substance represents the set of conditions at which the three phases coexist in equilibrium. For water, the triple point occurs at 273.16 K and 611 Pa. See Section 4.2 for details. 3.3 ENTROPY CHANGES ACCOMPANYING SPECIFIC PROCESSES 87 We now suppose that the system is isolated from its surroundings, so that dq = 0. The Clausius inequality implies that dS ≥ 0 and we conclude that in an isolated system the entropy cannot decrease when a spontaneous change occurs. This statement captures the content of the Second Law. 3.3 Entropy changes accompanying specific processes We now see how to calculate the entropy changes that accompany a variety of basic processes. (a) Expansion We established in Example 3.1 that the change in entropy of a perfect gas that expands isothermally from Vi to Vf is ∆S = nR ln (3.13)° Because S is a state function, the value of ∆S of the system is independent of the path between the initial and final states, so this expression applies whether the change of state occurs reversibly or irreversibly. The logarithmic dependence of entropy on volume is illustrated in Fig. 3.12. The total change in entropy, however, does depend on how the expansion takes place. For any process dqsur = −dq, and for a reversible change we use the expression in Example 3.1; consequently, from eqn 3.3b ∆Ssur = = − = −nR ln (3.14)° rev This change is the negative of the change in the system, so we can conclude that ∆Stot = 0, which is what we should expect for a reversible process. If the isothermal expansion occurs freely (w = 0) and irreversibly, then q = 0 (because ∆U = 0). Consequently, ∆Ssur = 0, and the total entropy change is given by eqn 3.13 itself: ∆Stot = nR ln (3.15)° In this case, ∆Stot > 0, as we expect for an irreversible process. (b) Phase transition The degree of dispersal of matter and energy changes when a substance freezes or boils as a result of changes in the order with which the molecules pack together and the extent to which the energy is localized or dispersed. Therefore, we should expect the transition to be accompanied by a change in entropy. For example, when a substance vaporizes, a compact condensed phase changes into a widely dispersed gas and we can expect the entropy of the substance to increase considerably. The entropy of a solid also increases when it melts to a liquid and when that liquid turns into a gas. Consider a system and its surroundings at the normal transition temperature, Ttrs, the temperature at which two phases are in equilibrium at 1 atm. This temperature is 0°C (273 K) for ice in equilibrium with liquid water at 1 atm, and 100°C (373 K) for water in equilibrium with its vapour at 1 atm. At the transition temperature, any transfer of energy as heat between the system and its surroundings is reversible Vf Vi Vf Vi qrev T qsur T Vf Vi 1 2 3 4 10 20 301 0 DSnR/ V Vf i/ Fig. 3.12 The logarithmic increase in entropy of a perfect gas as it expands isothermally. Exploration Evaluate the change in entropy that accompanies the expansion of 1.00 mol CO2(g) from 0.001 m3 to 0.010 m3 at 298 K, treated as a van der Waals gas. 88 3 THE SECOND LAW 4 Recall from Section 2.7 that ∆trsH is an enthalpy change per mole of substance; so ∆trsS is also a molar quantity. Synoptic Table 3.1* Standard entropies (and temperatures) of phase transitions, ∆trsS7 /(J K−1 mol−1 ) Fusion (at Tf) Vaporization (at Tb) Argon, Ar 14.17 (at 83.8 K) 74.53 (at 87.3 K) Benzene, C6H6 38.00 (at 279 K) 87.19 (at 353 K) Water, H2O 22.00 (at 273.15 K) 109.0 (at 373.15 K) Helium, He 4.8 (at 8 K and 30 bar) 19.9 (at 4.22K) * More values are given in the Data section. Synoptic Table 3.2* The standard entropies of vaporization of liquids ∆vapH7 /(kJ mol−1 ) θb/°C ∆vapS7 /(J K−1 mol−1 ) Benzene 30.8 80.1 87.2 Carbon tetrachloride 30 76.7 85.8 Cyclohexane 30.1 80.7 85.1 Hydrogen sulfide 18.7 −60.4 87.9 Methane 8.18 −161.5 73.2 Water 40.7 100.0 109.1 * More values are given in the Data section. because the two phases in the system are in equilibrium. Because at constant pressure q = ∆trsH, the change in molar entropy of the system is4 ∆trsS = (3.16) If the phase transition is exothermic (∆trsH < 0, as in freezing or condensing), then the entropy change is negative. This decrease in entropy is consistent with localization of matter and energy that accompanies the formation of a solid from a liquid or a liquid from a gas. If the transition is endothermic (∆trsH > 0, as in melting and vaporization), then the entropy change is positive, which is consistent with dispersal of energy and matter in the system. Table 3.1 lists some experimental entropies of transition. Table 3.2 lists in more detail the standard entropies of vaporization of several liquids at their boiling points. An interesting feature of the data is that a wide range of liquids give approximately the same standard entropy of vaporization (about 85 J K−1 mol−1 ): this empirical observation is called Trouton’s rule. Molecular interpretation 3.2 Trouton’s rule The explanation of Trouton’s rule is that a comparable change in volume occurs (with an accompanying change in the number of accessible microstates) when any liquid evaporates and becomes a gas. Hence, all liquids can be expected to have similar standard entropies of vaporization. ∆trsH Ttrs 3.3 ENTROPY CHANGES ACCOMPANYING SPECIFIC PROCESSES 89 Liquids that show significant deviations from Trouton’s rule do so on account of strong molecular interactions that restrict molecular motion. As a result, there is a greater dispersal of energy and matter when the liquid turns into a vapour than would occur for a liquid in which molcular motion is less restricted. An example is water, where the large entropy of vaporization reflects the presence of structure arising from hydrogen-bonding in the liquid. Hydrogen bonds tend to organize the molecules in the liquid so that they are less random than, for example, the molecules in liquid hydrogen sulfide (in which there is no hydrogen bonding). Methane has an unusually low entropy of vaporization. A part of the reason is that the entropy of the gas itself is slightly low (186 J K−1 mol−1 at 298 K); the entropy of N2 under the same conditions is 192 J K−1 mol−1 . As we shall see in Chapter 13, small molecules are difficult to excite into rotation; as a result, only a few rotational states are accessible at room temperature and, consequently, the number of rotational energy levels among which energy can be dispersed is low. Illustration 3.3 Using Trouton’s rule There is no hydrogen bonding in liquid bromine and Br2 is a heavy molecule that is unlikely to display unusual behaviour in the gas phase, so it is probably safe to use Trouton’s rule. To predict the standard molar enthalpy of vaporization of bromine given that it boils at 59.2°C, we use the rule in the form ∆vapH7 = Tb × (85 J K−1 mol−1 ) Substitution of the data then gives ∆vapH7 = (332.4 K) × (85 J K−1 mol−1 ) = +2.8 × 103 J mol−1 = +28 kJ mol−1 The experimental value is +29.45 kJ mol−1 . Self-test 3.3 Predict the enthalpy of vaporization of ethane from its boiling point, −88.6°C. [16 kJ mol−1 ] (c) Heating We can use eqn 3.2 to calculate the entropy of a system at a temperature Tf from a knowledge of its entropy at a temperature Ti and the heat supplied to change its temperature from one value to the other: S(Tf) = S(Ti) + Ύ Tf Ti (3.17) We shall be particularly interested in the entropy change when the system is subjected to constant pressure (such as from the atmosphere) during the heating. Then, from the definition of constant-pressure heat capacity (eqn 2.22), dqrev = CpdT provided the system is doing no non-expansion work. Consequently, at constant pressure: S(Tf) = S(Ti) + Ύ Tf Ti (3.18) The same expression applies at constant volume, but with Cp replaced by CV. When Cp is independent of temperature in the temperature range of interest, it can be taken outside the integral and we obtain CpdT T dqrev T 90 3 THE SECOND LAW 10 20 301 0 DSnR/ T Tf i/ 5 10 15 1 2 3 4 Fig. 3.13 The logarithmic increase in entropy of a substance as it is heated at constant volume. Different curves correspond to different values of the constant-volume heat capacity (which is assumed constant over the temperature range) expressed as CV,m/R. Exploration Plot the change in entropy of a perfect gas of (a) atoms, (b) linear rotors, (c) nonlinear rotors as the sample is heated over the same range under conditions of (i) constant volume, (ii) constant pressure. S(Tf) = S(Ti) + Cp Ύ Tf Ti = S(Ti) + Cp ln (3.19) with a similar expression for heating at constant volume. The logarithmic dependence of entropy on temperature is illustrated in Fig. 3.13. Example 3.2 Calculating the entropy change Calculate the entropy change when argon at 25°C and 1.00 bar in a container of volume 0.500 dm3 is allowed to expand to 1.000 dm3 and is simultaneously heated to 100°C. Method Because S is a state function, we are free to choose the most convenient path from the initial state. One such path is reversible isothermal expansion to the final volume, followed by reversible heating at constant volume to the final temperature. The entropy change in the first step is given by eqn 3.13 and that of the second step, provided CV is independent of temperature, by eqn 3.19 (with CV in place of Cp). In each case we need to know n, the amount of gas molecules, and can calculate it from the perfect gas equation and the data for the initial state from n = piVi/RTi. The heat capacity at constant volume is given by the equipartition theorem as 3 –2R. (The equipartition theorem is reliable for monatomic gases: for others and in general use experimental data like that in Table 2.7, converting to the value at constant volume by using the relation Cp,m − CV,m = R.) Answer Because n = piVi/RTi, from eqn 3.13 ∆S(Step 1) = × R ln = ln The entropy change in the second step, from 298 K to 373 K at constant volume, is ∆S(Step 2) = × 3 –2R ln = ln 3/2 The overall entropy change, the sum of these two changes, is ∆S = ln + ln 3/2 = ln 3/2 At this point we substitute the data and obtain (by using 1 Pa m3 = 1 J) ∆S = ln 3/2 = +0.173 J K−1 A note on good practice It is sensible to proceed as generally as possible before inserting numerical data so that, if required, the formula can be used for other data and to avoid rounding errors. Self-test 3.4 Calculate the entropy change when the same initial sample is compressed to 0.0500 dm3 and cooled to −25°C. [−0.44 J K−1 ] 5 6 7 D F 373 298 A C 1.000 0.500 1 2 3 (1.00 × 105 Pa) × (0.500 × 10−3 m3 ) 298 K 5 6 7 D F Tf Ti A C Vf Vi 1 2 3 piVi Ti D F Tf Ti A C piVi Ti Vf Vi piVi Ti D F Tf Ti A C piVi Ti Tf Ti D F piVi RTi A C Vf Vi piVi Ti Vf Vi D F piVi RTi A C Tf Ti dT T 3.3 ENTROPY CHANGES ACCOMPANYING SPECIFIC PROCESSES 91 S S(0) 0 Tf Tf Tb Tb T T DvapS DfusS Melt Boil C /Tp Solid Liquid Gas Debye approximation (a) (b) Fig. 3.14 The calculation of entropy from heat capacity data. (a) The variation of Cp/T with the temperature for a sample. (b) The entropy, which is equal to the area beneath the upper curve up to the corresponding temperature, plus the entropy of each phase transition passed. Exploration Allow for the temperature dependence of the heat capacity by writing C = a + bT + c/T2 , and plot the change in entropy for different values of the three coefficients (including negative values of c). (d) The measurement of entropy The entropy of a system at a temperature T is related to its entropy at T = 0 by measuring its heat capacity Cp at different temperatures and evaluating the integral in eqn 3.18, taking care to add the entropy of transition (∆trsH/Ttrs) for each phase transition between T = 0 and the temperature of interest. For example, if a substance melts at Tf and boils at Tb, then its entropy above its boiling temperature is given by S(T) = S(0) + Ύ Tf 0 + + Ύ Tb Tf + + Ύ T Tb (3.20) All the properties required, except S(0), can be measured calorimetrically, and the integrals can be evaluated either graphically or, as is now more usual, by fitting a polynomial to the data and integrating the polynomial analytically. The former procedure is illustrated in Fig. 3.14: the area under the curve of Cp/T against T is the integral required. Because dT/T = d ln T, an alternative procedure is to evaluate the area under a plot of Cp against ln T. One problem with the determination of entropy is the difficulty of measuring heat capacities near T = 0. There are good theoretical grounds for assuming that the heat capacity is proportional to T3 when T is low (see Section 8.1), and this dependence is the basis of the Debye extrapolation. In this method, Cp is measured down to as low a temperature as possible, and a curve of the form aT3 is fitted to the data. That fit determines the value of a, and the expression Cp = aT3 is assumed valid down to T = 0. Illustration 3.4 Calculating a standard molar entropy The standard molar entropy of nitrogen gas at 25°C has been calculated from the following data: S7 m/(J K−1 mol−1 ) Debye extrapolation 1.92 Integration, from 10 K to 35.61 K 25.25 Phase transition at 35.61 K 6.43 Integration, from 35.61 K to 63.14 K 23.38 Fusion at 63.14 K 11.42 Integration, from 63.14 K to 77.32 K 11.41 Vaporization at 77.32 K 72.13 Integration, from 77.32 K to 298.15 K 39.20 Correction for gas imperfection 0.92 Total 192.06 Therefore, Sm(298.15 K) = Sm(0) + 192.1 J K−1 mol−1 Example 3.3 Calculating the entropy at low temperatures The molar constant-pressure heat capacity of a certain solid at 4.2 K is 0.43 J K−1 mol−1 . What is its molar entropy at that temperature? Cp(g)dT T ∆vapH Tb Cp(1)dT T ∆fusH Tf Cp(s)dT T 92 3 THE SECOND LAW Method Because the temperature is so low, we can assume that the heat capacity varies with temperature as aT3 , in which case we can use eqn 3.18 to calculate the entropy at a temperature T in terms of the entropy at T = 0 and the constant a. When the integration is carried out, it turns out that the result can be expressed in terms of the heat capacity at the temperature T, so the data can be used directly to calculate the entropy. Answer The integration required is S(T) = S(0) + Ύ T 0 = S(0) + a Ύ T 0 T2 dT = S(0) + 1 –3aT3 However, because aT3 is the heat capacity at the temperature T, S(T) = S(0) + 1 –3Cp(T) from which it follows that Sm(10 K) = Sm(0) + 0.14 J K−1 mol−1 Self-test 3.5 For metals, there is also a contribution to the heat capacity from the electrons which is linearly proportional to T when the temperature is low. Find its contribution to the entropy at low temperatures. [S(T) = S(0) + Cp(T)] 3.4 The Third Law of thermodynamics At T = 0, all energy of thermal motion has been quenched, and in a perfect crystal all the atoms or ions are in a regular, uniform array. The localization of matter and the absence of thermal motion suggest that such materials also have zero entropy. This conclusion is consistent with the molecular interpretation of entropy, because S = 0 if there is only one way of arranging the molecules and only one microstate is accessible (the ground state). (a) The Nernst heat theorem The experimental observation that turns out to be consistent with the view that the entropy of a regular array of molecules is zero at T = 0 is summarized by the Nernst heat theorem: The entropy change accompanying any physical or chemical transformation approaches zero as the temperature approaches zero: ∆S → 0 as T → 0 provided all the substances involved are perfectly crystalline. Illustration 3.5 Using the Nernst heat theorem Consider the entropy of the transition between orthorhombic sulfur, S(α), and monoclinic sulfur, S(β), which can be calculated from the transition enthalpy (−402 J mol−1 ) at the transition temperature (369 K): ∆trsS = Sm(α) − Sm(β) = = −1.09 J K−1 mol−1 The two individual entropies can also be determined by measuring the heat capacities from T = 0 up to T = 369 K. It is found that Sm(α) = Sm(α,0) + 37 J K−1 mol−1 (−402 J mol−1 ) 369 K aT3 dT T 3.4 THE THIRD LAW OF THEMODYNAMICS 93 Synoptic Table 3.3* Standard Third-Law entropies at 298 K S7 m/(J K−1 mol−1 ) Solids Graphite, C(s) 5.7 Diamond, C(s) 2.4 Sucrose, C12H22O11(s) 360.2 Iodine, I2(s) 116.1 Liquids Benzene, C6H6(l) 173.3 Water, H2O(l) 69.9 Mercury, Hg(l) 76.0 Gases Methane, CH4(g) 186.3 Carbon dioxide, CO2(g) 213.7 Hydrogen, H2(g) 130.7 Helium, He 126.2 Ammonia, NH3(g) 126.2 * More values are given in the Data section. and Sm(β) = Sm(β,0) + 38 J K−1 mol−1 . These two values imply that at the transition temperature ∆trsS = Sm(α,0) − Sm(β,0) = −1 J K−1 mol−1 On comparing this value with the one above, we conclude that Sm(α,0) − Sm(β,0) ≈ 0, in accord with the theorem. It follows from the Nernst theorem that, if we arbitrarily ascribe the value zero to the entropies of elements in their perfect crystalline form at T = 0, then all perfect crystalline compounds also have zero entropy at T = 0 (because the change in entropy that accompanies the formation of the compounds, like the entropy of all transformations at that temperature, is zero). This conclusion is summarized by the Third Law of thermodynamics: The entropy of all perfect crystalline substances is zero at T = 0. As far as thermodynamics is concerned, choosing this common value as zero is then a matter of convenience. The molecular interpretation of entropy, however, justifies the value S = 0 at T = 0. Molecular interpretation 3.3 The statistical view of the Third Law of thermodynamics We saw in Molecular interpretation 3.1 that, according to the Boltzmann formula, the entropy is zero if there is only one accessible microstate (W = 1). In most cases, W = 1 at T = 0 because there is only one way of achieving the lowest total energy: put all the molecules into the same, lowest state. Therefore, S = 0 at T = 0, in accord with the Third Law of thermodynamics. In certain cases, though, W may differ from 1 at T = 0. This is the case if there is no energy advantage in adopting a particular orientation even at absolute zero. For instance, for a diatomic molecule AB there may be almost no energy difference between the arrangements . . . AB AB AB . . . and . . . BA AB BA . . . , so W > 1 even at T = 0. If S > 0 at T = 0 we say that the substance has a residual entropy. Ice has a residual entropy of 3.4 J K−1 mol−1 . It stems from the arrangement of the hydrogen bonds between neighbouring water molecules: a given O atom has two short O-H bonds and two long O···H bonds to its neighbours, but there is a degree of randomness in which two bonds are short and which two are long. (b) Third-Law entropies Entropies reported on the basis that S(0) = 0 are called Third-Law entropies (and often just ‘entropies’). When the substance is in its standard state at the temperature T, the standard (Third-Law) entropy is denoted S7 (T). A list of values at 298 K is given in Table 3.3. The standard reaction entropy, ∆rS7 , is defined, like the standard reaction enthalpy, as the difference between the molar entropies of the pure, separated products and the pure, separated reactants, all substances being in their standard states at the specified temperature: ∆rS7 = Products ∑νS7 m − Reactants ∑νS7 m (3.21) In this expression, each term is weighted by the appropriate stoichiometric coefficient. Standard reaction entropies are likely to be positive if there is a net formation of gas in a reaction, and are likely to be negative if there is a net consumption of gas. 94 3 THE SECOND LAW 5 In terms of the language to be introduced in Section 5.1, the entropies of ions in solution are actually partial molar entropies, for their values include the consequences of their presence on the organization of the solvent molecules around them. Illustration 3.6 Calculating a standard reaction entropy To calculate the standard reaction entropy of H2(g) + 1–2 O2(g) → H2O(l) at 25°C, we use the data in Table 2.7 of the Data Section to write ∆rS7 = S7 m(H2O, l) − {S7 m(H2, g) + 1 –2S7 m(O2, g)} = 69.9 J K−1 mol−1 − {130.7 + 1 –2(205.0)} J K−1 mol−1 = −163.4 J K−1 mol−1 The negative value is consistent with the conversion of two gases to a compact liquid. A note on good practice Do not make the mistake of setting the standard molar entropies of elements equal to zero: they have non-zero values (provided T > 0), as we have already discussed. Self-test 3.6 Calculate the standard reaction entropy for the combustion of methane to carbon dioxide and liquid water at 25°C. [−243 J K−1 mol−1 ] Just as in the discussion of enthalpies in Section 2.8, where we acknowledged that solutions of cations cannot be prepared in the absence of anions, the standard molar entropies of ions in solution are reported on a scale in which the standard entropy of the H+ ions in water is taken as zero at all temperatures: S7 (H+ , aq) = 0 [3.22] The values based on this choice are listed in Table 2.7 in the Data section.5 Because the entropies of ions in water are values relative to the hydrogen ion in water, they may be either positive or negative. A positive entropy means that an ion has a higher molar entropy than H+ in water and a negative entropy means that the ion has a lower molar entropy than H+ in water. For instance, the standard molar entropy of Cl− (aq) is +57 J K−1 mol−1 and that of Mg2+ (aq) is −128 J K−1 mol−1 . Ion entropies vary as expected on the basis that they are related to the degree to which the ions order the water molecules around them in the solution. Small, highly charged ions induce local structure in the surrounding water, and the disorder of the solution is decreased more than in the case of large, singly charged ions. The absolute, Third-Law standard molar entropy of the proton in water can be estimated by proposing a model of the structure it induces, and there is some agreement on the value −21 J K−1 mol−1 . The negative value indicates that the proton induces order in the solvent. Concentrating on the system Entropy is the basic concept for discussing the direction of natural change, but to use it we have to analyse changes in both the system and its surroundings. We have seen that it is always very simple to calculate the entropy change in the surroundings, and we shall now see that it is possible to devise a simple method for taking that contribution into account automatically. This approach focuses our attention on the system 3.5 THE HELMHOLTZ AND GIBBS ENERGIES 95 and simplifies discussions. Moreover, it is the foundation of all the applications of chemical thermodynamics that follow. 3.5 The Helmholtz and Gibbs energies Consider a system in thermal equilibrium with its surroundings at a temperature T. When a change in the system occurs and there is a transfer of energy as heat between the system and the surroundings, the Clausius inequality, eqn 3.12, reads dS − ≥ 0 (3.23) We can develop this inequality in two ways according to the conditions (of constant volume or constant pressure) under which the process occurs. (a) Criteria for spontaneity First, consider heating at constant volume. Then, in the absence of non-expansion work, we can write dqV = dU; consequently dS − ≥ 0 (3.24) The importance of the inequality in this form is that it expresses the criterion for spontaneous change solely in terms of the state functions of the system. The inequality is easily rearranged to TdS ≥ dU (constant V, no additional work)6 (3.25) At either constant internal energy (dU = 0) or constant entropy (dS = 0), this expression becomes, respectively, dSU,V ≥ 0 dUS,V ≤ 0 (3.26) where the subscripts indicate the constant conditions. Equation 3.26 expresses the criteria for spontaneous change in terms of properties relating to the system. The first inequality states that, in a system at constant volume and constant internal energy (such as an isolated system), the entropy increases in a spontaneous change. That statement is essentially the content of the Second Law. The second inequality is less obvious, for it says that, if the entropy and volume of the system are constant, then the internal energy must decrease in a spontaneous change. Do not interpret this criterion as a tendency of the system to sink to lower energy. It is a disguised statement about entropy, and should be interpreted as implying that, if the entropy of the system is unchanged, then there must be an increase in entropy of the surroundings, which can be achieved only if the energy of the system decreases as energy flows out as heat. When energy is transferred as heat at constant pressure, and there is no work other than expansion work, we can write dqp = dH and obtain TdS ≥ dH (constant p, no additional work) (3.27) At either constant enthalpy or constant entropy this inequality becomes, respectively, dSH,p ≥ 0 dHS,p ≤ 0 (3.28) The interpretations of these inequalities are similar to those of eqn 3.26. The entropy of the system at constant pressure must increase if its enthalpy remains constant (for dU T dq T 6 Recall that ‘additional work’ is work other than expansion work. 96 3 THE SECOND LAW there can then be no change in entropy of the surroundings). Alternatively, the enthalpy must decrease if the entropy of the system is constant, for then it is essential to have an increase in entropy of the surroundings. Because eqns 3.25 and 3.27 have the forms dU − TdS ≤ 0 and dH − TdS ≤ 0, respectively, they can be expressed more simply by introducing two more thermodynamic quantities. One is the Helmholtz energy, A, which is defined as A = U − TS [3.29] The other is the Gibbs energy, G: G = H − TS [3.30] All the symbols in these two definitions refer to the system. When the state of the system changes at constant temperature, the two properties change as follows: (a) dA = dU − TdS (b) dG = dH − TdS (3.31) When we introduce eqns 3.25 and 3.27, respectively, we obtain the criteria of spontaneous change as (a) dAT,V ≤ 0 (b) dGT,p ≤ 0 (3.32) These inequalities are the most important conclusions from thermodynamics for chemistry. They are developed in subsequent sections and chapters. (b) Some remarks on the Helmholtz energy A change in a system at constant temperature and volume is spontaneous if dAT,V ≤ 0. That is, a change under these conditions is spontaneous if it corresponds to a decrease in the Helmholtz energy. Such systems move spontaneously towards states of lower A if a path is available. The criterion of equilibrium, when neither the forward nor reverse process has a tendency to occur, is dAT,V = 0 (3.33) The expressions dA = dU − TdS and dA < 0 are sometimes interpreted as follows. A negative value of dA is favoured by a negative value of dU and a positive value of TdS. This observation suggests that the tendency of a system to move to lower A is due to its tendency to move towards states of lower internal energy and higher entropy. However, this interpretation is false (even though it is a good rule of thumb for remembering the expression for dA) because the tendency to lower A is solely a tendency towards states of greater overall entropy. Systems change spontaneously if in doing so the total entropy of the system and its surroundings increases, not because they tend to lower internal energy. The form of dA may give the impression that systems favour lower energy, but that is misleading: dS is the entropy change of the system, −dU/T is the entropy change of the surroundings (when the volume of the system is constant), and their total tends to a maximum. (c) Maximum work It turns out that A carries a greater significance than being simply a signpost of spontaneous change: the change in the Helmholtz function is equal to the maximum work accompanying a process: dwmax = dA (3.34) Asaresult,Aissometimescalledthe‘maximumworkfunction’,orthe‘workfunction’.7 7 Arbeit is the German word for work; hence the symbol A. 3.5 THE HELMHOLTZ AND GIBBS ENERGIES 97 Surroundings System q | | < | |w UD D D U S < 0 < 0 DSsur > 0 Fig. 3.15 In a system not isolated from its surroundings, the work done may be different from the change in internal energy. Moreover, the process is spontaneous if overall the entropy of the global, isolated system increases. In the process depicted here, the entropy of the system decreases, so that of the surroundings must increase in order for the process to be spontaneous, which means that energy must pass from the system to the surroundings as heat. Therefore, less work than ∆U can be obtained. Justification 3.2 Maximum work To demonstrate that maximum work can be expressed in terms of the changes in Helmholtz energy, we combine the Clausius inequality dS ≥ dq/T in the form TdS ≥ dq with the First Law, dU = dq + dw, and obtain dU ≤ TdS + dw (dU is smaller than the term on the right because we are replacing dq by TdS, which in general is larger.) This expression rearranges to dw ≥ dU − TdS It follows that the most negative value of dw, and therefore the maximum energy that can be obtained from the system as work, is given by dwmax = dU − TdS and that this work is done only when the path is traversed reversibly (because then the equality applies). Because at constant temperature dA = dU − TdS, we conclude that dwmax = dA. When a macroscopic isothermal change takes place in the system, eqn 3.34 becomes wmax = ∆A (3.35) with ∆A = ∆U − T∆S (3.36) This expression shows that in some cases, depending on the sign of T∆S, not all the change in internal energy may be available for doing work. If the change occurs with a decrease in entropy (of the system), in which case T∆S < 0, then the right-hand side of this equation is not as negative as ∆U itself, and consequently the maximum work is less than ∆U. For the change to be spontaneous, some of the energy must escape as heat in order to generate enough entropy in the surroundings to overcome the reduction in entropy in the system (Fig. 3.15). In this case, Nature is demanding a tax on the internal energy as it is converted into work. This is the origin of the alternative name ‘Helmholtz free energy’ for A, because ∆A is that part of the change in internal energy that we are free to use to do work. Molecular interpretation 3.4 Maximum work and the Helmholtz energy Further insight into the relation between the work that a system can do and the Helmholtz energy is obtained by recalling that work is energy transferred to the surroundings as the uniform motion of atoms. We can interpret the expression A = U − TS as showing that A is the total internal energy of the system, U, less a contribution that is stored as energy of thermal motion (the quantity TS). Because energy stored in random thermal motion cannot be used to achieve uniform motion in the surroundings, only the part of U that is not stored in that way, the quantity U − TS, is available for conversion into work. If the change occurs with an increase of entropy of the system (in which case T∆S > 0), the right-hand side of the equation is more negative than ∆U. In this case, the maximum work that can be obtained from the system is greater than ∆U. The explanation of this apparent paradox is that the system is not isolated and energy may 98 3 THE SECOND LAW Surroundings System q | | > | |w UD D D U S < 0 > 0 DSsur < 0 Fig. 3.16 In this process, the entropy of the system increases; hence we can afford to lose some entropy of the surroundings. That is, some of their energy may be lost as heat to the system. This energy can be returned to them as work. Hence the work done can exceed ∆U. flow in as heat as work is done. Because the entropy of the system increases, we can afford a reduction of the entropy of the surroundings yet still have, overall, a spontaneous process. Therefore, some energy (no more than the value of T∆S) may leave the surroundings as heat and contribute to the work the change is generating (Fig. 3.16). Nature is now providing a tax refund. Example 3.4 Calculating the maximum available work When 1.000 mol C6H12O6 (glucose) is oxidized to carbon dioxide and water at 25°C according to the equation C6H12O6(s) + 6 O2(g) → 6 CO2(g) + 6 H2O(l), calorimetric measurements give ∆rU7 = −2808 kJ mol−1 and ∆rS = +182.4 J K−1 mol−1 at 25°C. How much of this energy change can be extracted as (a) heat at constant pressure, (b) work? Method We know that the heat released at constant pressure is equal to the value of ∆H, so we need to relate ∆rH7 to ∆rU7 , which is given. To do so, we suppose that all the gases involved are perfect, and use eqn 2.21 in the form ∆rH = ∆rU + ∆νgRT. For the maximum work available from the process we use eqn 3.34. Answer (a) Because ∆νg = 0, we know that ∆rH7 = ∆rU7 = −2808 kJ mol−1 . Therefore, at constant pressure, the energy available as heat is 2808 kJ mol−1 . (b) Because T = 298 K, the value of ∆rA7 is ∆rA7 = ∆rU7 − T∆rS7 = −2862 kJ mol−1 Therefore, the combustion of 1.000 mol C6H12O6 can be used to produce up to 2862 kJ of work. The maximum work available is greater than the change in internal energy on account of the positive entropy of reaction (which is partly due to the generation of a large number of small molecules from one big one). The system can therefore draw in energy from the surroundings (so reducing their entropy) and make it available for doing work. Self-test 3.7 Repeat the calculation for the combustion of 1.000 mol CH4(g) under the same conditions, using data from Table 2.5. [|qp| = 890 kJ, |wmax| = 813 kJ] (d) Some remarks on the Gibbs energy The Gibbs energy (the ‘free energy’) is more common in chemistry than the Helmholtz energy because, at least in laboratory chemistry, we are usually more interested in changes occurring at constant pressure than at constant volume. The criterion dGT,p ≤ 0 carries over into chemistry as the observation that, at constant temperature and pressure, chemical reactions are spontaneous in the direction of decreasing Gibbs energy. Therefore, if we want to know whether a reaction is spontaneous, the pressure and temperature being constant, we assess the change in the Gibbs energy. If G decreases as the reaction proceeds, then the reaction has a spontaneous tendency to convert the reactants into products. If G increases, then the reverse reaction is spontaneous. The existence of spontaneous endothermic reactions provides an illustration of the role of G. In such reactions, H increases, the system rises spontaneously to states of higher enthalpy, and dH > 0. Because the reaction is spontaneous we know that dG < 0 despite dH > 0; it follows that the entropy of the system increases so much that TdS outweighs dH in dG = dH − TdS. Endothermic reactions are therefore driven by the increase of entropy of the system, and this entropy change overcomes the reduction of entropy brought about in the surroundings by the inflow of heat into the system (dSsur = −dH/T at constant pressure). 3.5 THE HELMHOLTZ AND GIBBS ENERGIES 99 (e) Maximum non-expansion work The analogue of the maximum work interpretation of ∆A, and the origin of the name ‘free energy’, can be found for ∆G. In the Justification below, we show that, at constant temperature and pressure, the maximum additional (non-expansion) work, wadd,max, is given by the change in Gibbs energy: dwadd,max = dG (3.37) The corresponding expression for a measurable change is wadd,max = ∆G (3.38) This expression is particularly useful for assessing the electrical work that may be produced by fuel cells and electrochemical cells, and we shall see many applications of it. Justification 3.3 Maximum non-expansion work Because H = U + pV, for a general change in conditions, the change in enthalpy is dH = dq + dw + d(pV) The corresponding change in Gibbs energy (G = H − TS) is dG = dH − TdS − SdT = dq + dw + d(pV) − TdS − SdT When the change is isothermal we can set dT = 0; then dG = dq + dw + d(pV) − TdS When the change is reversible, dw = dwrev and dq = dqrev = TdS, so for a reversible, isothermal process dG = TdS + dwrev + d(pV) − TdS = dwrev + d(pV) The work consists of expansion work, which for a reversible change is given by −pdV, and possibly some other kind of work (for instance, the electrical work of pushing electrons through a circuit or of raising a column of liquid); this additional work we denote dwadd. Therefore, with d(pV) = pdV + Vdp, dG = (−pdV + dwadd,rev) + pdV + Vdp = dwadd,rev + Vdp If the change occurs at constant pressure (as well as constant temperature), we can set dp = 0 and obtain dG = dwadd,rev. Therefore, at constant temperature and pressure, dwadd,rev = dG . However, because the process is reversible, the work done must now have its maximum value, so eqn 3.37 follows. Example 3.5 Calculating the maximum non-expansion work of a reaction How much energy is available for sustaining muscular and nervous activity from the combustion of 1.00 mol of glucose molecules under standard conditions at 37°C (blood temperature)? The standard entropy of reaction is +182.4 J K−1 mol−1 . Method The non-expansion work available from the reaction is equal to the change in standard Gibbs energy for the reaction (∆rG7 , a quantity defined more fully below). To calculate this quantity, it is legitimate to ignore the temperaturedependence of the reaction enthalpy, to obtain ∆rH7 from Table 2.5, and to substitute the data into ∆rG7 = ∆rH7 − T∆rS7 . Answer Because the standard reaction enthalpy is −2808 kJ mol−1 , it follows that the standard reaction Gibbs energy is ∆rG7 = −2808 kJ mol−1 − (310 K) × (182.4 J K−1 mol−1 ) = −2865 kJ mol−1 100 3 THE SECOND LAW 8 The reference state of an element was defined in Section 2.7. Synoptic Table 3.4* Standard Gibbs energies of formation (at 298 K) ∆fG7 /(kJ mol−1 ) Diamond, C(s) +2.9 Benzene, C6H6(l) +124.3 Methane, CH4(g) −50.7 Carbon dioxide, CO2(g) −394.4 Water, H2O(l) −237.1 Ammonia, NH3(g) −16.5 Sodium chloride, NaCl(s) −384.1 * More values are given in the Data section. Therefore, wadd,max = −2865 kJ for the combustion of 1 mol glucose molecules, and the reaction can be used to do up to 2865 kJ of non-expansion work. To place this result in perspective, consider that a person of mass 70 kg needs to do 2.1 kJ of work to climb vertically through 3.0 m; therefore, at least 0.13 g of glucose is needed to complete the task (and in practice significantly more). Self-test 3.8 How much non-expansion work can be obtained from the combustion of 1.00 mol CH4(g) under standard conditions at 298 K? Use ∆rS7 = −243 J K−1 mol−1 . [818 kJ] 3.6 Standard reaction Gibbs energies Standard entropies and enthalpies of reaction can be combined to obtain the standard Gibbs energy of reaction (or ‘standard reaction Gibbs energy’), ∆rG7 : ∆rG7 = ∆rH7 − T∆rS7 [3.39] The standard Gibbs energy of reaction is the difference in standard molar Gibbs energies of the products and reactants in their standard states at the temperature specified for the reaction as written. As in the case of standard reaction enthalpies, it is convenient to define the standard Gibbs energies of formation, ∆fG7 , the standard reaction Gibbs energy for the formation of a compound from its elements in their reference states.8 Standard Gibbs energies of formation of the elements in their reference states are zero, because their formation is a ‘null’ reaction. A selection of values for compounds is given in Table 3.4. From the values there, it is a simple matter to obtain the standard Gibbs energy of reaction by taking the appropriate combination: ∆rG7 = Products ∑ν∆fG7 − Reactants ∑ν∆fG7 (3.40) with each term weighted by the appropriate stoichiometric coefficient. Illustration 3.7 Calculating a standard Gibbs energy of reaction To calculate the standard Gibbs energy of the reaction CO(g) + 1 –2 O2(g) → CO2(g) at 25°C, we write ∆rG7 = ∆fG7 (CO2, g) − {∆fG7 (CO, g) + 1 –2∆fG7 (O2, g)} = −394.4 kJ mol−1 − {(−137.2) + 1 –2(0)} kJ mol−1 = −257.2 kJ mol−1 Self-test 3.9 Calculate the standard reaction Gibbs energy for the combustion of CH4(g) at 298 K. [−818 kJ mol−1 ] Just as we did in Section 2.8, where we acknowledged that solutions of cations cannot be prepared without their accompanying anions, we define one ion, conventionally the hydrogen ion, to have zero standard Gibbs energy of formation at all temperatures: ∆fG7 (H+ , aq) = 0 [3.41] 3.6 STANDARD MOLAR GIBBS ENERGIES 101 Comment 3.2 The standard Gibbs energies of formation of the gas-phase ions are unknown. We have therefore used ionization energies (the energies associated with the removal of electrons from atoms or cations in the gas phase) or electron affinities (the energies associated with the uptake of electrons by atoms or anions in the gas phase) and have assumed that any differences from the Gibbs energies arising from conversion to enthalpy and the inclusion of entropies to obtain Gibbs energies in the formation of H+ are cancelled by the corresponding terms in the electron gain of X. The conclusions from the cycles are therefore only approximate. H (g) Cl(g) e+ _ + + H (g) Cl (g) e + + +2 H(g) Cl (g)+ 2 2 2H (g) Cl (g)+ H (g) Cl (g)+ - + H (g) Cl (aq) + - + H (aq) Cl (aq) + - + -349 -295 +106 +70 +1312 +1312 +218 +218 (a) (b) DsolvG (Cl )- D + D{ (H , aq) (Cl , aq)}f fG G+ H (g) I(g) e+ _ + + H (g) I (g) e + + +2 H (g) I (g)+ – + H (g) I (aq)+ - + H(g) I (s)+ 2 DsolvG (H ) + - D + D{ (H , aq) (I , aq)}f fG G+ H (aq) I (aq) + + DsolvG (I )– DsolvG (H ) + 2 2H (g) I (g)+ 1 2- 1 2- 1 2- 1 2- 1 2- 1 2- 1 2- 1 2- °– °– °– °– °– °– °– °– Fig. 3.17 The thermodynamic cycles for the discussion of the Gibbs energies of solvation (hydration) and formation of (a) chloride ions, (b) iodide ions in aqueous solution. The sum of the changes in Gibbs energies around the cycle sum to zero because G is a state function. In essence, this definition adjusts the actual values of the Gibbs energies of formation of ions by a fixed amount, which is chosen so that the standard value for one of them, H+ (aq), has the value zero. Then for the reaction 1 –2 H2(g) + 1 –2 Cl2(g) → H+ (aq) + Cl− (aq) ∆rG7 = −131.23 kJ mol−1 we can write ∆rG7 = ∆fG7 (H+ , aq) + ∆fG7 (Cl− , aq) = ∆fG7 (Cl− , aq) and hence identify ∆fG7 (Cl− , aq) as −131.23 kJ mol−1 . All the Gibbs energies of formation of ions tabulated in the Data section were calculated in the same way. Illustration 3.8 Calculating the standard Gibbs energy of formation of an ion With the value of ∆fG7 (Cl− , aq) established, we can find the value of ∆fG7 (Ag+ , aq) from Ag(s) + 1 –2 Cl2(g) → Ag+ (aq) + Cl− (aq) ∆rG7 = −54.12 kJ mol−1 which leads to ∆fG7 (Ag+ , aq) = +77.11 kJ mol−1 . The factors responsible for the magnitude of the Gibbs energy of formation of an ion in solution can be identified by analysing it in terms of a thermodynamic cycle. As an illustration, we consider the standard Gibbs energies of formation of Cl− in water, which is −131 kJ mol−1 . We do so by treating the formation reaction 1 –2 H2(g) + 1 –2 X2(g) → H+ (aq) + X− (aq) as the outcome of the sequence of steps shown in Fig. 3.17 (with values taken from the Data section). The sum of the Gibbs energies for all the steps around a closed cycle is zero, so ∆fG7 (Cl− , aq) = 1272 kJ mol−1 + ∆solvG7 (H+ ) + ∆solvG7 (Cl− ) 102 3 THE SECOND LAW Comment 3.3 The NIST WebBook is a good source of links to online databases of thermochemical data. An important point to note is that the value of ∆fG7 of an ion X is not determined by the properties of X alone but includes contributions from the dissociation, ionization, and hydration of hydrogen. Gibbs energies of solvation of individual ions may be estimated from an equation derived by Max Born, who identified ∆solvG7 with the electrical work of transferring an ion from a vacuum into the solvent treated as a continuous dielectric of relative permittivity εr. The resulting Bornequation, which is derived in Further information 3.1, is ∆solvG7 = − 1 − (3.42a) where zi is the charge number of the ion and ri its radius (NA is Avogadro’s constant). Note that ∆solvG7 < 0, and that ∆solvG7 is strongly negative for small, highly charged ions in media of high relative permittivity. For water at 25°C, ∆solvG7 = − × (6.86 × 104 kJ mol−1 ) (3.42b) Illustration 3.9 Using the Born equation To see how closely the Born equation reproduces the experimental data, we calculate the difference in the values of ∆fG7 for Cl− and I− in water, for which εr = 78.54 at 25°C, given their radii as 181 pm and 220 pm (Table 20.3), respectively, is ∆solvG7 (Cl− ) − ∆solvG7 (I− ) = − − × (6.86 × 104 kJ mol−1 ) = −67 kJ mol−1 This estimated difference is in good agreement with the experimental difference, which is −61 kJ mol−1 . Self-test 3.10 Estimate the value of ∆solvG7 (Cl− , aq) − ∆solvG7 (Br− , aq) from experimental data and from the Born equation. [−26 kJ mol−1 experimental; −29 kJ mol−1 calculated] Calorimetry (for ∆H directly, and for S via heat capacities) is only one of the ways of determining Gibbs energies. They may also be obtained from equilibrium constants and electrochemical measurements (Chapter 7), and for gases they may be calculated using data from spectroscopic observations (Chapter 17). Combining the First and Second Laws The First and Second Laws of thermodynamics are both relevant to the behaviour of matter, and we can bring the whole force of thermodynamics to bear on a problem by setting up a formulation that combines them. 3.7 The fundamental equation We have seen that the First Law of thermodynamics may be written dU = dq + dw. For a reversible change in a closed system of constant composition, and in the absence of D F 1 220 1 181 A C zi 2 (ri/pm) D F 1 εr A C zi 2 e2 NA 8πε0ri 3.8 PROPERTIES OF THE INTERNAL ENERGY 103 any additional (non-expansion) work, we may set dwrev = −pdV and (from the definition of entropy) dqrev = TdS, where p is the pressure of the system and T its temperature. Therefore, for a reversible change in a closed system, dU = TdS − pdV (3.43) However, because dU is an exact differential, its value is independent of path. Therefore, the same value of dU is obtained whether the change is brought about irreversibly or reversibly. Consequently, eqn 3.43 applies to any change—reversible or irreversible— of a closed system that does no additional (non-expansion) work. We shall call this combination of the First and Second Laws the fundamental equation. The fact that the fundamental equation applies to both reversible and irreversible changes may be puzzling at first sight. The reason is that only in the case of a reversible change may TdS be identified with dq and −pdV with dw. When the change is irreversible, TdS > dq (the Clausius inequality) and −pdV > dw. The sum of dw and dq remains equal to the sum of TdS and −pdV, provided the composition is constant. 3.8 Properties of the internal energy Equation 3.43 shows that the internal energy of a closed system changes in a simple way when either S or V is changed (dU ∝ dS and dU ∝ dV). These simple proportionalities suggest that U should be regarded as a function of S and V. We could regard U as a function of other variables, such as S and p or T and V, because they are all interrelated; but the simplicity of the fundamental equation suggests that U(S,V) is the best choice. The mathematical consequence of U being a function of S and V is that we can express an infinitesimal change dU in terms of changes dS and dV by dU = V dS + S dV (3.44) The two partial derivatives are the slopes of the plots of U against S and V, respectively. When this expression is compared to the thermodynamic relation, eqn 3.43, we see that, for systems of constant composition, V = T S = −p (3.45) The first of these two equations is a purely thermodynamic definition of temperature (a Zeroth-Law concept) as the ratio of the changes in the internal energy (a First-Law concept) and entropy (a Second-Law concept) of a constant-volume, closed, constantcomposition system. We are beginning to generate relations between the properties of a system and to discover the power of thermodynamics for establishing unexpected relations. (a) The Maxwell relations An infinitesimal change in a function f(x,y) can be written df = gdx + hdy where g and h are functions of x and y. The mathematical criterion for df being an exact differential (in the sense that its integral is independent of path) is that x = y (3.46) Because the fundamental equation, eqn 3.43, is an expression for an exact differential, the functions multiplying dS and dV (namely T and −p) must pass this test. Therefore, it must be the case that D F ∂h ∂x A C D F ∂g ∂y A C D F ∂U ∂V A C D F ∂U ∂S A C D F ∂U ∂V A C D F ∂U ∂S A C Comment 3.4 Partial derivatives were introduced in Comment 2.5 and are reviewed in Appendix 2. The type of result in eqn 3.44 was first obtained in Section 2.11, where we treated U as a function of T and V. Comment 3.5 To illustrate the criterion set by eqn 3.46, let’s test whether df = 2xydx + x2 dy is an exact differential. We identify g = 2xy and h = x2 and form x = x = 2x y = y = 2x Because these two coefficients are equal, df is exact. D E F ∂x2 ∂x A B C D E F ∂h ∂x A B C D E F ∂(2xy) ∂y A B C D E F ∂g ∂y A B C 104 3 THE SECOND LAW Table 3.5 The Maxwell relations From U: S = − V From H: S = p From A: V = T From G: p = − T D E F ∂S ∂p A C D E F ∂V ∂T A B C D E F ∂S ∂V A C D E F ∂p ∂T A B C D E F ∂V ∂S A C D E F ∂T ∂p A B C D E F ∂p ∂S A C D E F ∂T ∂V A B C S = − V (3.47) We have generated a relation between quantities that, at first sight, would not seem to be related. Equation 3.47 is an example of a Maxwell relation. However, apart from being unexpected, it does not look particularly interesting. Nevertheless, it does suggest that there may be other similar relations that are more useful. Indeed, we can use the fact that H, G, and A are all state functions to derive three more Maxwell relations. The argument to obtain them runs in the same way in each case: because H, G, and A are state functions, the expressions for dH, dG, and dA satisfy relations like eqn 3.47. All four relations are listed in Table 3.5 and we put them to work later in the chapter. (b) The variation of internal energy with volume The quantity πT = (∂U/∂V)T, which represents how the internal energy changes as the volume of a system is changed isothermally, played a central role in the manipulation of the First Law, and in Further information 2.2 we used the relation πT = T V − p (3.48) This relation is called a thermodynamic equation of state because it is an expression for pressure in terms of a variety of thermodynamic properties of the system. We are now ready to derive it by using a Maxwell relation. Justification 3.4 The thermodynamic equation of state We obtain an expression for the coefficient πT by dividing both sides of eqn 3.43 by dV, imposing the constraint of constant temperature, which gives T = V T + S Next, we introduce the two relations in eqn 3.45 and the definition of πT to obtain πT = T T − p The third Maxwell relation in Table 3.5 turns (∂S/∂V)T into (∂p/∂T)V, which completes the proof of eqn 3.48. Example 3.6 Deriving a thermodynamic relation Show thermodynamically that πT = 0 for a perfect gas, and compute its value for a van der Waals gas. Method Proving a result ‘thermodynamically’ means basing it entirely on general thermodynamic relations and equations of state, without drawing on molecular arguments (such as the existence of intermolecular forces). We know that for a perfect gas, p = nRT/V, so this relation should be used in eqn 3.48. Similarly, the van der Waals equation is given in Table 1.7, and for the second part of the question it should be used in eqn 3.48. Answer For a perfect gas we write D E F ∂S ∂V A B C D E F ∂U ∂V A B C D E F ∂S ∂V A B C D E F ∂U ∂S A B C D E F ∂U ∂V A B C D F ∂p ∂T A C D F ∂p ∂S A C D F ∂T ∂V A C 3.9 PROPERTIES OF THE GIBBS ENERGY 105 V = V = Then, eqn 3.48 becomes πT = − p = 0 The equation of state of a van der Waals gas is p = − a Because a and b are independent of temperature, V = Therefore, from eqn 3.48, πT = − + a = a This result for πT implies that the internal energy of a van der Waals gas increases when it expands isothermally (that is, (∂U/∂V)T > 0), and that the increase is related to the parameter a, which models the attractive interactions between the particles. A larger molar volume, corresponding to a greater average separation between molecules, implies weaker mean intermolecular attractions, so the total energy is greater. Self-test 3.11 Calculate πT for a gas that obeys the virial equation of state (Table 1.7). [πT = RT2 (∂B/∂T)V/Vm 2 + · · · ] 3.9 Properties of the Gibbs energy The same arguments that we have used for U can be used for the Gibbs energy G = H − TS. They lead to expressions showing how G varies with pressure and temperature that are important for discussing phase transitions and chemical reactions. (a) General considerations When the system undergoes a change of state, G may change because H, T, and S all change. As in Justification 2.1, we write for infinitesimal changes in each property dG = dH − d(TS) = dH − TdS − SdT Because H = U + pV, we know that dH = dU + d(pV) = dU + pdV + Vdp and therefore dG = dU + pdV + Vdp − TdS − SdT For a closed system doing no non-expansion work, we can replace dU by the fundamental equation dU = TdS − pdV and obtain dG = TdS − pdV + pdV + Vdp − TdS − SdT n2 V2 n2 V2 nRT V − nb nRT V − nb nR V − nb D F ∂p ∂T A C n2 V2 nRT V − nb nRT V nR V D F ∂(nRT/V) ∂T A C D F ∂p ∂T A C 106 3 THE SECOND LAW Four terms now cancel on the right, and we conclude that, for a closed system in the absence of non-expansion work and at constant composition, dG = Vdp − SdT (3.49) This expression, which shows that a change in G is proportional to a change in p or T, suggests that G may be best regarded as a function of p and T. It confirms that G is an important quantity in chemistry because the pressure and temperature are usually the variables under our control. In other words, G carries around the combined consequences of the First and Second Laws in a way that makes it particularly suitable for chemical applications. The same argument that led to eqn 3.45, when applied to the exact differential dG = Vdp − SdT, now gives p = −S T = V (3.50) These relations show how the Gibbs energy varies with temperature and pressure (Fig. 3.18). The first implies that: • Because S > 0 for all substances, G always decreases when the temperature is raised (at constant pressure and composition). • Because (∂G/∂T)p becomes more negative as S increases, G decreases most sharply when the entropy of the system is large. Therefore, the Gibbs energy of the gaseous phase of a substance, which has a high molar entropy, is more sensitive to temperature than its liquid and solid phases (Fig. 3.19). Similarly, the second relation implies that: • Because V > 0 for all substances, G always increases when the pressure of the system is increased (at constant temperature and composition). D F ∂G ∂p A C D F ∂G ∂T A C Pressure, p Tem perature, T Gibbs energy, G Slope = V Slope = -S Fig. 3.18 The variation of the Gibbs energy of a system with (a) temperature at constant pressure and (b) pressure at constant temperature. The slope of the former is equal to the negative of the entropy of the system and that of the latter is equal to the volume. Temperature, T Gibbsenergy,G Gas Liquid Solid Fig. 3.19 The variation of the Gibbs energy with the temperature is determined by the entropy. Because the entropy of the gaseous phase of a substance is greater than that of the liquid phase, and the entropy of the solid phase is smallest, the Gibbs energy changes most steeply for the gas phase, followed by the liquid phase, and then the solid phase of the substance. 3.9 PROPERTIES OF THE GIBBS ENERGY 107 • Because (∂G/∂p)T increases with V, G is more sensitive to pressure when the volume of the system is large. Because the molar volume of the gaseous phase of a substance is greater than that of its condensed phases, the molar Gibbs energy of a gas is more sensitive to pressure than its liquid and solid phases (Fig. 3.20). (b) The variation of the Gibbs energy with temperature As we remarked in the introduction, because the equilibrium composition of a system depends on the Gibbs energy, to discuss the response of the composition to temperature we need to know how G varies with temperature. The first relation in eqn 3.50, (∂G/∂T)p = −S, is our starting point for this discussion. Although it expresses the variation of G in terms of the entropy, we can express it in terms of the enthalpy by using the definition of G to write S = (H − G)/T. Then p = (3.51) We shall see later that the equilibrium constant of a reaction is related to G/T rather than to G itself,9 and it is easy to deduce from the last equation (see the Justification below) that p = − (3.52) This expression is called the Gibbs–Helmholtz equation. It shows that if we know the enthalpy of the system, then we know how G/T varies with temperature. Justification 3.5 The Gibbs–Helmholtz equation First, we note that p = p + G = p − = p − Then we use eqn 3.51 in the form p − = − It follows that p = − = − which is eqn 3.52. The Gibbs–Helmholtz equation is most useful when it is applied to changes, including changes of physical state and chemical reactions at constant pressure. Then, because ∆G = Gf − Gi for the change of Gibbs energy between the final and initial states and because the equation applies to both Gf and Gi, we can write H T2 5 6 7 H T 1 2 3 1 T D E F G T ∂ ∂T A B C H T G T D E F ∂G ∂T A B C 5 6 7 G T D E F ∂G ∂T A B C 1 2 3 1 T G T2 D E F ∂G ∂T A B C 1 T 1 T d dT D E F ∂G ∂T A B C 1 T D E F G T ∂ ∂T A B C H T2 D F G T ∂ ∂T A C G − H T D F ∂G ∂T A C Gibbsenergy,G Gas Liquid Solid Pressure, p Fig. 3.20 The variation of the Gibbs energy with the pressure is determined by the volume of the sample. Because the volume of the gaseous phase of a substance is greater than that of the same amount of liquid phase, and the entropy of the solid phase is smallest (for most substances), the Gibbs energy changes most steeply for the gas phase, followed by the liquid phase, and then the solid phase of the substance. Because the volumes of the solid and liquid phases of a substance are similar, their molar Gibbs energies vary by similar amounts as the pressure is changed. 9 In Section 7.2b we derive the result that the equilibrium constant for a reaction is related to its standard reaction Gibbs energy by ∆rG7 /T = −R ln K. Comment 3.6 For this step, we use the rule for differentiating a product of functions (which is valid for partial derivatives as well as ordinary derivatives): = u + V For instance, to differentiate x2 eax , we write u v = x2 + eax = ax2 eax + 2xeax dx2 dx deax dx d(x2 eax ) dx # $ # $ du dx dV dx duV dx 108 3 THE SECOND LAW Pressure, p Volume,V Dp Volume assumed constant Actual volume pf pi Fig. 3.21 The difference in Gibbs energy of a solid or liquid at two pressures is equal to the rectangular area shown. We have assumed that the variation of volume with pressure is negligible. Pressure, p Volume,V V nRT p= / òV pd pi pf Fig. 3.22 The difference in Gibbs energy for a perfect gas at two pressures is equal to the area shown below the perfect-gas isotherm. p = − (3.53) This equation shows that, if we know the change in enthalpy of a system that is undergoing some kind of transformation (such as vaporization or reaction), then we know how the corresponding change in Gibbs energy varies with temperature. As we shall see, this is a crucial piece of information in chemistry. (c) The variation of the Gibbs energy with pressure To find the Gibbs energy at one pressure in terms of its value at another pressure, the temperature being constant, we set dT = 0 in eqn 3.49, which gives dG = Vdp, and integrate: G(pf) = G(pi) + Ύ pf pi V dp (3.54a) For molar quantities, Gm(pf) = Gm(pi) + Ύ pf pi Vm dp (3.54b) This expression is applicable to any phase of matter, but to evaluate it we need to know how the molar volume, Vm, depends on the pressure. The molar volume of a condensed phase changes only slightly as the pressure changes (Fig. 3.21), so we can treat Vm as a constant and take it outside the integral: Gm(pf) = Gm(pi) + VmΎ pf pi dp = Gm(pi) + (pf − pi)Vm (3.55) Self-test 3.12 Calculate the change in Gm for ice at −10°C, with density 917 kg m−3 , when the pressure is increased from 1.0 bar to 2.0 bar. [+2.0 J mol−1 ] Under normal laboratory conditions (pf − pi)Vm is very small and may be neglected. Hence, we may usually suppose that the Gibbs energies of solids and liquids are independent of pressure. However, if we are interested in geophysical problems, then because pressures in the Earth’s interior are huge, their effect on the Gibbs energy cannot be ignored. If the pressures are so great that there are substantial volume changes over the range of integration, then we must use the complete expression, eqn 3.54. Illustration 3.10 Gibbs energies at high pressures Suppose that for a certain phase transition of a solid ∆trsV = +1.0 cm3 mol−1 independent of pressure. Then, for an increase in pressure to 3.0 Mbar (3.0 × 1011 Pa) from 1.0 bar (1.0 × 105 Pa), the Gibbs energy of the transition changes from ∆trsG(1 bar) to ∆trsG(3Mbar)=∆trsG(1bar)+(1.0×10−6 m3 mol−1 )×(3.0×1011 Pa−1.0×105 Pa) = ∆trsG(1 bar) + 3.0 × 102 kJ mol−1 where we have used 1 Pa m3 = 1 J. The molar volumes of gases are large, so the Gibbs energy of a gas depends strongly on the pressure. Furthermore, because the volume also varies markedly with the pressure, we cannot treat it as a constant in the integral in eqn 3.54b (Fig. 3.22). ∆H T2 D F ∆G T ∂ ∂T A C CHECKLIST OF KEY IDEAS 109 For a perfect gas we substitute Vm = RT/p into the integral, treat RT as a constant, and find Gm(pf) = Gm(pi) + RT Ύ pf pi = Gm(pi) + RT ln (3.56)° This expression shows that when the pressure is increased tenfold at room temperature, the molar Gibbs energy increases by RT ln 10 ≈ 6 kJ mol−1 . It also follows from this equation that, if we set pi = p7 (the standard pressure of 1 bar), then the molar Gibbs energy of a perfect gas at a pressure p (set pf = p) is related to its standard value by Gm(p) = G7 m + RT ln (3.57)° Self-test 3.13 Calculate the change in the molar Gibbs energy of water vapour (treated as a perfect gas) when the pressure is increased isothermally from 1.0 bar to 2.0 bar at 298 K. Note that, whereas the change in molar Gibbs energy for a condensed phase (Self-test 3.12) is a few joules per mole, the answer you should get for a gas is of the order of kilojoules per mole. [+1.7 kJ mol−1 ] The logarithmic dependence of the molar Gibbs energy on the pressure predicted by eqn 3.57 is illustrated in Fig. 3.23. This very important expression, the consequences of which we unfold in the following chapters, applies to perfect gases (which is usually a good enough approximation). Further information 3.2 describes how to take into account gas imperfections. p p7 pf pi dp p Checklist of key ideas 1. Kelvin statement of the Second Law of thermodynamics: No process is possible in which the sole result is the absorption of heat from a reservoir and its complete conversion into work. 2. The Second Law in terms of entropy: The entropy of an isolated system increases in the course of a spontaneous change: ∆Stot > 0. 3. The thermodynamic definition of entropy is dS = dqrev/T. The statistical definition of entropy is given by the Boltzmann formula, S = k ln W. 4. A Carnot cycle is a cycle composed of a sequence of isothermal and adiabatic reversible expansions and compressions. 5. The efficiency of a heat engine is ε = |w|/qh. The Carnot efficiency is εrev = 1 − Tc/Th. 6. The Kelvin scale is a thermodynamic temperature scale in which the triple point of water defines the point 273.16 K. 7. The Clausius inequality is dS ≥ dq/T. 8. The normal transition temperature, Ttrs, is the temperature at which two phases are in equilibrium at 1 atm. The entropy of transition at the transition temperature, ∆trsS = ∆trsH/Ttrs. 9. Trouton’s rule states that many normal liquids have approximately the same standard entropy of vaporization (about 85 J K−1 mol−1 ). 10. The variation of entropy with temperature is given by S(Tf) = S(Ti) + Ύ Tf Ti (Cp/T)dT. 11. The entropy of a substance is measured from the area under a graph of Cp/T against T, using the Debye extrapolation at low temperatures, Cp = aT3 as T → 0. 12. The Nernst heat theorem states that the entropy change accompanying any physical or chemical transformation approaches zero as the temperature approaches zero: ∆S → 0 as T → 0 provided all the substances involved are perfectly ordered. 13. Third Law of thermodynamics: The entropy of all perfect crystalline substances is zero at T = 0. 14. The standard reaction entropy is calculated from ∆rS7 = ∑ProductsνS7 m − ∑ReactantsνS7 m. 15. The standard molar entropies of ions in solution are reported on a scale in which S7 (H+ , aq) = 0 at all temperatures. Pressure, p-¥ p° MolarGibbsenergy,Gm Gm° Fig. 3.23 The molar Gibbs energy potential of a perfect gas is proportional to ln p, and the standard state is reached at p7 . Note that, as p → 0, the molar Gibbs energy becomes negatively infinite. Exploration Show how the first derivative of G, (∂G/∂p)T, varies with pressure, and plot the resulting expression over a pressure range. What is the physical significance of (∂G/∂p)T? 110 3 THE SECOND LAW 16. The Helmholtz energy is A = U − TS. The Gibbs energy is G = H − TS. 17. The criteria of spontaneity may be written as: (a) dSU,V ≥ 0 and dUS,V ≤ 0, or (b) dAT,V ≤ 0 and dGT,p ≤ 0. 18. The criterion of equilibrium at constant temperature and volume, dAT,V = 0. The criterion of equilibrium at constant temperature and pressure, dGT,p = 0. 19. The maximum work and the Helmholtz energy are related by wmax = ∆A. The maximum additional (non-expansion) work and the Gibbs energy are related by wadd,max = ∆G. 20. The standard Gibbs energy of reaction is given by ∆rG7 = ∆rH7 − T∆rS7 = ∑ProductsνG7 m − ∑ReactantsνG7 m. 21. The standard Gibbs energy of formation (∆fG7 ) is the standard reaction Gibbs energy for the formation of a compound from its elements in their reference states. 22. The standard Gibbs energy of reaction may be expressed in terms of ∆fG7 , ∆rG7 = ∑Productsν∆fG7 − ∑Reactantsν∆fG7 . 23. The standard Gibbs energies of formation of ions are reported on a scale in which ∆fG7 (H+ , aq) = 0 at all temperatures. 24. The fundamental equation is dU = TdS − pdV. 25. The Maxwell relations are listed in Table 3.5. 26. A thermodynamic equation of state is an expression for pressure in terms of thermodynamic quantities, πT = T(∂p/∂T)V − p. 27. The Gibbs energy is best described as a function of pressure and temperature, dG = Vdp − SdT. The variation of Gibbs energy with pressure and temperature are, respectively, (∂G/∂p)T = V and (∂G/∂T)p = −S. 28. The temperature dependence of the Gibbs energy is given by the Gibbs–Helmholtz equation, (∂(G/T)/∂T)p = −H/T2 . 29. For a condensed phase, the Gibbs energy varies with pressure as G(pf) = G(pi) + Vm∆p. For a perfect gas, G(pf) = G(pi) + nRT ln(pf/pi). Further reading 10 Articles and texts N.C. Craig, Entropy analyses of four familiar processes. J. Chem. Educ. 65, 760 (1988). J.B. Fenn, Engines, energy, and entropy. W.H. Freeman and Co., New York (1982). F.J. Hale, Heat engines and refrigerators. In Encyclopedia of applied physics (ed. G.L. Trigg), 7, 303. VCH, New York (1993). D. Kondepudi and I. Prigogine, Modern thermodynamics: from heat engines to dissipative structures. Wiley, New York (1998). P.G. Nelson, Derivation of the Second Law of thermodynamics from Boltzmann’s distribution law. J. Chem. Educ. 65, 390 (1988). Sources of data and information M.W. Chase, Jr. (ed.), NIST–JANAF thermochemical tables. Published as J. Phys. Chem. Ref. Data, Monograph no. 9. American Institute of Physics, New York (1998). R.C. Weast (ed.), Handbook of chemistry and physics, Vol. 81. CRC Press, Boca Raton (2004). 10 See Further reading in Chapter 2 for additional articles, texts, and sources of thermochemical data. Further information Further information 3.1 The Born equation The electrical concepts required in this derivation are reviewed in Appendix 3. The strategy of the calculation is to identify the Gibbs energy of solvation with the work of transferring an ion from a vacuum into the solvent. That work is calculated by taking the difference of the work of charging an ion when it is in the solution and the work of charging the same ion when it is in a vacuum. The Coulomb interaction between two charges q1 and q2 separated by a distance r is described by the Coulombic potential energy: V = where ε is the medium’s permittivity. The permittivity of vacuum is ε0 = 8.854 × 10−12 J−1 C2 m−1 . The relative permittivity (formerly q1q2 4πεr called the ‘dielectric constant’) of a substance is defined as εr = ε/ε0. Ions do not interact as strongly in a solvent of high relative permittivity (such as water, with εr = 80 at 293 K) as they do in a solvent of lower relative permittivity (such as ethanol, with εr = 25 at 293 K). See Chapter 18 for more details. The potential energy of a charge q1 in the presence of a charge q2 can be expressed in terms of the Coulomb potential, φ: V = q1φ φ = We model an ion as a sphere of radius ri immersed in a medium of permittivity ε. It turns out that, when the charge of the sphere is q, the electric potential, φ, at its surface is the same as the potential due to a point charge at its centre, so we can use the last expression and write q2 4πεr FURTHER INFORMATION 111 φ = The work of bringing up a charge dq to the sphere is φdq. Therefore, the total work of charging the sphere from 0 to zie is w = Ύ zie 0 φdq = Ύ zie 0 qdq = This electrical work of charging, when multiplied by Avogadro’s constant, is the molar Gibbs energy for charging the ions. The work of charging an ion in a vacuum is obtained by setting ε = ε0, the vacuum permittivity. The corresponding value for charging the ion in a medium is obtained by setting ε = εrε0, where εr is the relative permittivity of the medium. It follows that the change in molar Gibbs energy that accompanies the transfer of ions from a vacuum to a solvent is the difference of these two quantities: ∆solvG7 = − = − = − 1 − which is eqn 3.42. Further information 3.2 Real gases: the fugacity At various stages in the development of physical chemistry it is necessary to switch from a consideration of idealized systems to real systems. In many cases it is desirable to preserve the form of the expressions that have been derived for an idealized system. Then deviations from the idealized behaviour can be expressed most simply. For instance, the pressure-dependence of the molar Gibbs energy of a real gas might resemble that shown in Fig. 3.24. To adapt eqn 3.57 to this case, we replace the true pressure, p, by an effective pressure, called the fugacity,11 f, and write Gm = G7 m + RT ln [3.58] The fugacity, a function of the pressure and temperature, is defined so that this relation is exactly true. Although thermodynamic expressions in terms of fugacities derived from this expression are exact, they are useful only if we know how to interpret fugacities in terms of actual pressures. To develop this relation we write the fugacity as f = φp [3.59] where φ is the dimensionless fugacity coefficient, which in general depends on the temperature, the pressure, and the identity of the gas. Equation 3.54b is true for all gases whether real or perfect. Expressing it in terms of the fugacity by using eqn 3.58 turns it into Ύ p p′ Vmdp = Gm(p) − Gm(p′) = G7 m + RT ln − G7 m + RT ln = RT ln In this expression, f is the fugacity when the pressure is p and f′ is the fugacity when the pressure is p′. If the gas were perfect, we would write f f′ 5 6 7 f′ p7 1 2 3 5 6 7 f p7 1 2 3 f p7 D E F 1 εr A B C z2 ie2 NA 8πε0ri z2 ie2 NA 8πε0ri z2 ie2 NA 8πεrε0ri z2 ie2 NA 8πε0ri z2 ie2 NA 8πεri z2 ie2 8πεri 1 4πεri q 4πεri Ύ p p′ Vperfect, mdp = RT ln The difference between the two equations is Ύ p p′ (Vm − Vperfect, m)dp = RT ln − ln = RT ln = RT ln × which can be rearranged into ln × = Ύ p p′ (Vm − Vperfect, m)dp When p′ → 0, the gas behaves perfectly and f′ becomes equal to the pressure, p′. Therefore, f′/p′ → 1 as p′ → 0. If we take this limit, which means setting f′/p′ = 1 on the left and p′ = 0 on the right, the last equation becomes ln = Ύ p 0 (Vm − Vperfect, m)dp Then, with φ = f/p, lnφ = Ύ p 0 (Vm − Vperfect,m)dp For a perfect gas, Vperfect,m = RT/p. For a real gas, Vm = RTZ/p, where Z is the compression factor of the gas (Section 1.3). With these two substitutions, we obtain 1 RT 1 RT f p 1 RT D E F p′ f′ f p A B C D E F p′ p f f′ A B C D E F f/f′ p/p′ A B C D E F p p′ f f′ A B C p p′ Pressure, p -¥ p° Perfect gas Repulsions dominant ( > )f p Attractions dominant ( < )f p MolarGibbsenergy,Gm Gm °– Real gas Fig. 3.24 The molar Gibbs energy of a real gas. As p → 0, the molar Gibbs energy coincides with the value for a perfect gas (shown by the black line). When attractive forces are dominant (at intermediate pressures), the molar Gibbs energy is less than that of a perfect gas and the molecules have a lower ‘escaping tendency’. At high pressures, when repulsive forces are dominant, the molar Gibbs energy of a real gas is greater than that of a perfect gas. Then the ‘escaping tendency’ is increased. 11 The name ‘fugacity’ comes from the Latin for ‘fleetness’ in the sense of ‘escaping tendency’; fugacity has the same dimensions as pressure. 112 3 THE SECOND LAW lnφ = Ύ p 0 dp (3.60) Provided we know how Z varies with pressure up to the pressure of interest, this expression enable us to determine the fugacity coefficient and hence, through eqn 3.59, to relate the fugacity to the pressure of the gas. We see from Fig. 1.14 that for most gases Z < 1 up to moderate pressures, but that Z > 1 at higher pressures. If Z < 1 throughout the range of integration, then the integrand in eqn 3.60 is negative and φ < 1. This value implies that f < p (the molecules tend to stick together) and that the molar Gibbs energy of the gas is less than that of a perfect gas. At higher pressures, the range over which Z > 1 may dominate the range over which Z < 1. The integral is then positive, φ > 1, and f > p (the repulsive interactions are dominant and tend to drive the particles apart). Now the molar Gibbs energy of the gas is greater than that of the perfect gas at the same pressure. Figure 3.25, which has been calculated using the full van der Waals equation of state, shows how the fugacity coefficient depends on the Z − 1 p pressure in terms of the reduced variables (Section 1.5). Because critical constants are available in Table 1.6, the graphs can be used for quick estimates of the fugacities of a wide range of gases. Table 3.6 gives some explicit values for nitrogen. 0 20 40 60 80 2.5 2.0 1.5 1.0 Fugacitycoefficient,=/fp 5 6 8 10 15 20 25 35 Reduced pressure, /p pc 3.0 100 0 0.50 1.00 1.50 0 4 8 12 16 20 Fugacitycoefficient,=/fp Reduced pressure, /p pc 1.0 1.1 1.2 1.5 2.0 3.0 f f Fig. 3.25 The fugacity coefficient of a van der Waals gas plotted using the reduced variables of the gas. The curves are labelled with the reduced temperature Tr = T/Tc. Exploration Evaluate the fugacity coefficient as a function of the reduced volume of a van der Waals gas and plot the outcome for a selection of reduced temperatures over the range 0.8 ≤ Vr ≤ 3. Synoptic table 3.6* The fugacity of nitrogen at 273 K p/atm f/atm 1 0.999 55 10 9.9560 100 97.03 1000 1839 * More values are given in the Data section. Discussion questions 3.1 The evolution of life requires the organization of a very large number of molecules into biological cells. Does the formation of living organisms violate the Second Law of thermodynamics? State your conclusion clearly and present detailed arguments to support it. 3.2 You received an unsolicited proposal from a self-declared inventor who is seeking investors for the development of his latest idea: a device that uses heat extracted from the ground by a heat pump to boil water into steam that is used to heat a home and to power a steam engine that drives the heat pump. This procedure is potentially very lucrative because, after an initial extraction of energy from the ground, no fossil fuels would be required to keep the device running indefinitely. Would you invest in this idea? State your conclusion clearly and present detailed arguments to support it. 3.3 The following expressions have been used to establish criteria for spontaneous change: ∆Stot > 0, dSU,V ≥ 0 and dUS,V ≤ 0, dAT,V ≤ 0, and dGT,p ≤ 0. Discuss the origin, significance, and applicability of each criterion. 3.4 The following expressions have been used to establish criteria for reversibility: dAT,V = 0 and dGT,p = 0. Discuss the origin, significance, and applicability of each criterion. 3.5 Discuss the physical interpretation of any one Maxwell relation. 3.6 Account for the dependence of πT of a van der Waals gas in terms of the significance of the parameters a and b. 3.7 Suggest a physical interpretation of the dependence of the Gibbs energy on the pressure. 3.8 Suggest a physical interpretation of the dependence of the Gibbs energy on the temperature. EXERCISES 113 Exercises Assume that all gases are perfect and that data refer to 298.15 K unless otherwise stated. 3.1(a) Calculate the change in entropy when 25 kJ of energy is transferred reversibly and isothermally as heat to a large block of iron at (a) 0°C, (b) 100°C. 3.1(b) Calculate the change in entropy when 50 kJ of energy is transferred reversibly and isothermally as heat to a large block of copper at (a) 0°C, (b) 70°C. 3.2(a) Calculate the molar entropy of a constant-volume sample of neon at 500 K given that it is 146.22 J K−1 mol−1 at 298 K. 3.2(b) Calculate the molar entropy of a constant-volume sample of argon at 250 K given that it is 154.84 J K−1 mol−1 at 298 K. 3.3(a) Calculate ∆S (for the system) when the state of 3.00 mol of perfect gas atoms, for which Cp,m = 5 –2R, is changed from 25°C and 1.00 atm to 125°C and 5.00 atm. How do you rationalize the sign of ∆S? 3.3(b) Calculate ∆S (for the system) when the state of 2.00 mol diatomic perfect gas molecules, for which Cp,m = 7 –2R, is changed from 25°C and 1.50 atm to 135°C and 7.00 atm. How do you rationalize the sign of ∆S? 3.4(a) A sample consisting of 3.00 mol of diatomic perfect gas molecules at 200 K is compressed reversibly and adiabatically until its temperature reaches 250 K. Given that CV,m = 27.5 J K−1 mol−1 , calculate q, w, ∆U, ∆H, and ∆S. 3.4(b) A sample consisting of 2.00 mol of diatomic perfect gas molecules at 250 K is compressed reversibly and adiabatically until its temperature reaches 300 K. Given that CV,m = 27.5 J K−1 mol−1 , calculate q, w, ∆U, ∆H, and ∆S. 3.5(a) Calculate ∆H and ∆Stot when two copper blocks, each of mass 10.0 kg, one at 100°C and the other at 0°C, are placed in contact in an isolated container. The specific heat capacity of copper is 0.385 J K−1 g−1 and may be assumed constant over the temperature range involved. 3.5(b) Calculate ∆H and ∆Stot when two iron blocks, each of mass 1.00 kg, one at 200°C and the other at 25°C, are placed in contact in an isolated container. The specific heat capacity of iron is 0.449 J K−1 g−1 and may be assumed constant over the temperature range involved. 3.6(a) Consider a system consisting of 2.0 mol CO2(g), initially at 25°C and 10 atm and confined to a cylinder of cross-section 10.0 cm2 . It is allowed to expand adiabatically against an external pressure of 1.0 atm until the piston has moved outwards through 20 cm. Assume that carbon dioxide may be considered a perfect gas with CV,m = 28.8 J K−1 mol−1 and calculate (a) q, (b) w, (c) ∆U, (d) ∆T, (e) ∆S. 3.6(b) Consider a system consisting of 1.5 mol CO2(g), initially at 15°C and 9.0 atm and confined to a cylinder of cross-section 100.0 cm2 . The sample is allowed to expand adiabatically against an external pressure of 1.5 atm until the piston has moved outwards through 15 cm. Assume that carbon dioxide may be considered a perfect gas with CV,m = 28.8 J K−1 mol−1 , and calculate (a) q, (b) w, (c) ∆U, (d) ∆T, (e) ∆S. 3.7(a) The enthalpy of vaporization of chloroform (CHCl3) is 29.4 kJ mol−1 at its normal boiling point of 334.88 K. Calculate (a) the entropy of vaporization of chloroform at this temperature and (b) the entropy change of the surroundings. 3.7(b) The enthalpy of vaporization of methanol is 35.27 kJ mol−1 at its normal boiling point of 64.1°C. Calculate (a) the entropy of vaporization of methanol at this temperature and (b) the entropy change of the surroundings. 3.8(a) Calculate the standard reaction entropy at 298 K of (a) 2 CH3CHO(g) + O2(g) → 2 CH3COOH(l) (b) 2 AgCl(s) + Br2(l) → 2 AgBr(s) + Cl2(g) (c) Hg(l) + Cl2(g) → HgCl2(s) 3.8(b) Calculate the standard reaction entropy at 298 K of (a) Zn(s) + Cu2+ (aq) → Zn2+ (aq) + Cu(s) (b) C12H22O11(s) + 12 O2(g) → 12 CO2(g) + 11 H2O(l) 3.9(a) Combine the reaction entropies calculated in Exercise 3.8a with the reaction enthalpies, and calculate the standard reaction Gibbs energies at 298 K. 3.9(b) Combine the reaction entropies calculated in Exercise 3.8b with the reaction enthalpies, and calculate the standard reaction Gibbs energies at 298 K. 3.10(a) Use standard Gibbs energies of formation to calculate the standard reaction Gibbs energies at 298 K of the reactions in Exercise 3.8a. 3.10(b) Use standard Gibbs energies of formation to calculate the standard reaction Gibbs energies at 298 K of the reactions in Exercise 3.8b. 3.11(a) Calculate the standard Gibbs energy of the reaction 4 HCl(g) + O2(g) → 2 Cl2(g) + 2 H2O(l) at 298 K, from the standard entropies and enthalpies of formation given in the Data section. 3.11(b) Calculate the standard Gibbs energy of the reaction CO(g) + CH3OH(l) → CH3COOH(l) at 298 K, from the standard entropies and enthalpies of formation given in the Data section. 3.12(a) The standard enthalpy of combustion of solid phenol (C6H5OH) is −3054 kJ mol−1 at 298 K and its standard molar entropy is 144.0 J K−1 mol−1 . Calculate the standard Gibbs energy of formation of phenol at 298 K. 3.12(b) The standard enthalpy of combustion of solid urea (CO(NH2)2) is −632 kJ mol−1 at 298 K and its standard molar entropy is 104.60 J K−1 mol−1 . Calculate the standard Gibbs energy of formation of urea at 298 K. 3.13(a) Calculate the change in the entropies of the system and the surroundings, and the total change in entropy, when a sample of nitrogen gas of mass 14 g at 298 K and 1.00 bar doubles its volume in (a) an isothermal reversible expansion, (b) an isothermal irreversible expansion against pex = 0, and (c) an adiabatic reversible expansion. 3.13(b) Calculate the change in the entropies of the system and the surroundings, and the total change in entropy, when the volume of a sample of argon gas of mass 21 g at 298 K and 1.50 bar increases from 1.20 dm3 to 4.60 dm3 in (a) an isothermal reversible expansion, (b) an isothermal irreversible expansion against pex = 0, and (c) an adiabatic reversible expansion. 3.14(a) Calculate the maximum non-expansion work per mole that may be obtained from a fuel cell in which the chemical reaction is the combustion of methane at 298 K. 3.14(b) Calculate the maximum non-expansion work per mole that may be obtained from a fuel cell in which the chemical reaction is the combustion of propane at 298 K. 3.15(a) (a) Calculate the Carnot efficiency of a primitive steam engine operating on steam at 100°C and discharging at 60°C. (b) Repeat the calculation for a modern steam turbine that operates with steam at 300°C and discharges at 80°C. 114 3 THE SECOND LAW 3.15(b) A certain heat engine operates between 1000 K and 500 K. (a) What is the maximum efficiency of the engine? (b) Calculate the maximum work that can be done by for each 1.0 kJ of heat supplied by the hot source. (c) How much heat is discharged into the cold sink in a reversible process for each 1.0 kJ supplied by the hot source? 3.16(a) Suppose that 3.0 mmol N2(g) occupies 36 cm3 at 300 K and expands to 60 cm3 . Calculate ∆G for the process. 3.16(b) Suppose that 2.5 mmol Ar(g) occupies 72 dm3 at 298 K and expands to 100 dm3 . Calculate ∆G for the process. 3.17(a) The change in the Gibbs energy of a certain constant-pressure process was found to fit the expression ∆G/J = −85.40 + 36.5(T/K). Calculate the value of ∆S for the process. 3.17(b) The change in the Gibbs energy of a certain constant-pressure process was found to fit the expression ∆G/J = −73.1 + 42.8(T/K). Calculate the value of ∆S for the process. 3.18(a) Calculate the change in Gibbs energy of 35 g of ethanol (mass density 0.789 g cm−3 ) when the pressure is increased isothermally from 1 atm to 3000 atm. 3.18(b) Calculate the change in Gibbs energy of 25 g of methanol (mass density 0.791 g cm−3 ) when the pressure is increased isothermally from 100 kPa to 100 MPa. 3.19(a) Calculate the change in chemical potential of a perfect gas when its pressure is increased isothermally from 1.8 atm to 29.5 atm at 40°C. 3.19(b) Calculate the change in chemical potential of a perfect gas when its pressure is increased isothermally from 92.0 kPa to 252.0 kPa at 50°C. 3.20(a) The fugacity coefficient of a certain gas at 200 K and 50 bar is 0.72. Calculate the difference of its molar Gibbs energy from that of a perfect gas in the same state. 3.20(b) The fugacity coefficient of a certain gas at 290 K and 2.1 MPa is 0.68. Calculate the difference of its molar Gibbs energy from that of a perfect gas in the same state. 3.21(a) Estimate the change in the Gibbs energy of 1.0 dm3 of benzene when the pressure acting on it is increased from 1.0 atm to 100 atm. 3.21(b) Estimate the change in the Gibbs energy of 1.0 dm3 of water when the pressure acting on it is increased from 100 kPa to 300 kPa. 3.22(a) Calculate the change in the molar Gibbs energy of hydrogen gas when its pressure is increased isothermally from 1.0 atm to 100.0 atm at 298 K. 3.22(b) Calculate the change in the molar Gibbs energy of oxygen when its pressure is increased isothermally from 50.0 kPa to 100.0 kPa at 500 K. Problems* Assume that all gases are perfect and that data refer to 298 K unless otherwise stated. Numerical problems 3.1 Calculate the difference in molar entropy (a) between liquid water and ice at −5°C, (b) between liquid water and its vapour at 95°C and 1.00 atm. The differences in heat capacities on melting and on vaporization are 37.3 J K−1 mol−1 and −41.9 J K−1 mol−1 , respectively. Distinguish between the entropy changes of the sample, the surroundings, and the total system, and discuss the spontaneity of the transitions at the two temperatures. 3.2 The heat capacity of chloroform (trichloromethane, CHCl3) in the range 240 K to 330 K is given by Cp,m/(J K−1 mol−1 ) = 91.47 + 7.5 × 10−2 (T/K). In a particular experiment, 1.00 mol CHCl3 is heated from 273 K to 300 K. Calculate the change in molar entropy of the sample. 3.3 A block of copper of mass 2.00 kg (Cp,m = 24.44 J K−1 mol−1 ) and temperature 0°C is introduced into an insulated container in which there is 1.00 mol H2O(g) at 100°C and 1.00 atm. (a) Assuming all the steam is condensed to water, what will be the final temperature of the system, the heat transferred from water to copper, and the entropy change of the water, copper, and the total system? (b) In fact, some water vapour is present at equilibrium. From the vapour pressure of water at the temperature calculated in (a), and assuming that the heat capacities of both gaseous and liquid water are constant and given by their values at that temperature, obtain an improved value of the final temperature, the heat transferred, and the various entropies. (Hint. You will need to make plausible approximations.) 3.4 Consider a perfect gas contained in a cylinder and separated by a frictionless adiabatic piston into two sections A and B. All changes in B is isothermal; that is, a thermostat surrounds B to keep its temperature constant. There is 2.00 mol of the gas in each section. Initially, TA = TB = 300 K, VA = VB = 2.00 dm3 . Energy is supplied as heat to Section A and the piston moves to the right reversibly until the final volume of Section B is 1.00 dm3 . Calculate (a) ∆SA and ∆SB, (b) ∆AA and ∆AB, (c) ∆GA and ∆GB, (d) ∆S of the total system and its surroundings. If numerical values cannot be obtained, indicate whether the values should be positive, negative, or zero or are indeterminate from the information given. (Assume CV,m = 20 J K−1 mol−1 .) 3.5 A Carnot cycle uses 1.00 mol of a monatomic perfect gas as the working substance from an initial state of 10.0 atm and 600 K. It expands isothermally to a pressure of 1.00 atm (Step 1), and then adiabatically to a temperature of 300 K (Step 2). This expansion is followed by an isothermal compression (Step 3), and then an adiabatic compression (Step 4) back to the initial state. Determine the values of q, w, ∆U, ∆H, ∆S, ∆Stot, and ∆G for each stage of the cycle and for the cycle as a whole. Express your answer as a table of values. 3.6 1.00 mol of perfect gas molecules at 27°C is expanded isothermally from an initial pressure of 3.00 atm to a final pressure of 1.00 atm in two ways: (a) reversibly, and (b) against a constant external pressure of 1.00 atm. Determine the values of q, w, ∆U, ∆H, ∆S, ∆Ssur, ∆Stot for each path. 3.7 The standard molar entropy of NH3(g) is 192.45 J K−1 mol−1 at 298 K, and its heat capacity is given by eqn 2.25 with the coefficients given in Table 2.2. Calculate the standard molar entropy at (a) 100°C and (b) 500°C. 3.8 A block of copper of mass 500 g and initially at 293 K is in thermal contact with an electric heater of resistance 1.00 kΩ and negligible mass. A current of 1.00 A is passed for 15.0 s. Calculate the change in entropy of the copper, taking Cp,m = 24.4 J K−1 mol−1 . The experiment is then repeated with the copper immersed in a stream of water that maintains its temperature at 293 K. Calculate the change in entropy of the copper and the water in this case. 3.9 Find an expression for the change in entropy when two blocks of the same substance and of equal mass, one at the temperature Th and the other at Tc, are brought into thermal contact and allowed to reach equilibrium. Evaluate the * Problems denoted with the symbol ‡ were supplied by Charles Trapp, Carmen Giunta, and Marshall Cady. PROBLEMS 115 change for two blocks of copper, each of mass 500 g, with Cp,m = 24.4 J K−1 mol−1 , taking Th = 500 K and Tc = 250 K. 3.10 A gaseous sample consisting of 1.00 mol molecules is described by the equation of state pVm = RT(1 + Bp). Initially at 373 K, it undergoes Joule– Thomson expansion from 100 atm to 1.00 atm. Given that Cp,m = 5 –2R, µ = 0.21 K atm−1 , B = −0.525(K/T) atm−1 , and that these are constant over the temperature range involved, calculate ∆T and ∆S for the gas. 3.11 The molar heat capacity of lead varies with temperature as follows: T/K 10 15 20 25 30 50 Cp,m/(J K−1 mol−1 ) 2.8 7.0 10.8 14.1 16.5 21.4 T/K 70 100 150 200 250 298 Cp,m/(J K−1 mol−1 ) 23.3 24.5 25.3 25.8 26.2 26.6 Calculate the standard Third-Law entropy of lead at (a) 0°C and (b) 25°C. 3.12 From standard enthalpies of formation, standard entropies, and standard heat capacities available from tables in the Data section, calculate the standard enthalpies and entropies at 298 K and 398 K for the reaction CO2(g) + H2(g) → CO(g) + H2O(g). Assume that the heat capacities are constant over the temperature range involved. 3.13 The heat capacity of anhydrous potassium hexacyanoferrate(II) varies with temperature as follows: T/K Cp,m/(J K−1 mol−1 ) T/K Cp,m/(J K −1 mol−1 ) 10 2.09 100 179.6 20 14.43 110 192.8 30 36.44 150 237.6 40 62.55 160 247.3 50 87.03 170 256.5 60 111.0 180 265.1 70 131.4 190 273.0 80 149.4 200 280.3 90 165.3 Calculate the molar enthalpy relative to its value at T = 0 and the Third-Law entropy at each of these temperatures. 3.14 The compound 1,3,5-trichloro-2,4,6-trifluorobenzene is an intermediate in the conversion of hexachlorobenzene to hexafluorobenzene, and its thermodynamic properties have been examined by measuring its heat capacity over a wide temperature range (R.L. Andon and J.F. Martin, J. Chem. Soc. Faraday Trans. I. 871 (1973)). Some of the data are as follows: T/K 14.14 16.33 20.03 31.15 44.08 64.81 Cp,m/(J K−1 mol−1 ) 9.492 12.70 18.18 32.54 46.86 66.36 T/K 100.90 140.86 183.59 225.10 262.99 298.06 Cp,m/(J K−1 mol−1 ) 95.05 121.3 144.4 163.7 180.2 196.4 Calculate the molar enthalpy relative to its value at T = 0 and the Third-Law molar entropy of the compound at these temperatures. 3.15‡ Given that S7 m = 29.79 J K−1 mol−1 for bismuth at 100 K and the following tabulated heat capacities data (D.G. Archer, J. Chem. Eng. Data 40, 1015 (1995)), compute the standard molar entropy of bismuth at 200 K. T/K 100 120 140 150 160 180 200 Cp,m/(J K−1 mol−1 ) 23.00 23.74 24.25 24.44 24.61 24.89 25.11 Compare the value to the value that would be obtained by taking the heat capacity to be constant at 24.44 J K−1 mol−1 over this range. 3.16 Calculate ∆rG7 (375 K) for the reaction 2 CO(g) + O2(g) → 2 CO2(g) from the value of ∆rG7 (298 K), ∆rH7 (298 K), and the Gibbs–Helmholtz equation. 3.17 Estimate the standard reaction Gibbs energy of N2(g) + 3 H2(g) → 2 NH3(g) at (a) 500 K, (b) 1000 K from their values at 298 K. 3.18 At 200 K, the compression factor of oxygen varies with pressure as shown below. Evaluate the fugacity of oxygen at this temperature and 100 atm. p/atm 1.0000 4.00000 7.00000 10.0000 40.00 70.00 100.0 Z 0.9971 0.98796 0.97880 0.96956 0.8734 0.7764 0.6871 Theoretical problems 3.19 Represent the Carnot cycle on a temperature–entropy diagram and show that the area enclosed by the cycle is equal to the work done. 3.20 Prove that two reversible adiabatic paths can never cross. Assume that the energy of the system under consideration is a function of temperature only. (Hint. Suppose that two such paths can intersect, and complete a cycle with the two paths plus one isothermal path. Consider the changes accompanying each stage of the cycle and show that they conflict with the Kelvin statement of the Second Law.) 3.21 Prove that the perfect gas temperature scale and the thermodynamic temperature scale based on the Second Law of thermodynamics differ from each other by at most a constant numerical factor. 3.22 The molar Gibbs energy of a certain gas is given by Gm = RT ln p + A + Bp + 1 –2Cp2 + 1 –3Dp3 , where A, B, C, and D are constants. Obtain the equation of state of the gas. 3.23 Evaluate (∂S/∂V)T for (a) a van der Waals gas, (b) a Dieterici gas (Table 1.7). For an isothermal expansion, for which kind of gas (and a perfect gas) will ∆S be greatest? Explain your conclusion. 3.24 Show that, for a perfect gas, (∂U/∂S)V = T and (∂U/∂V)S = −p. 3.25 Two of the four Maxwell relations were derived in the text, but two were not. Complete their derivation by showing that (∂S/∂V)T = (∂p/∂T)V and (∂T/∂p)S = (∂V/∂S)p. 3.26 Use the Maxwell relations to express the derivatives (a) (∂S/∂V)T and (∂V/∂S)p and (b) (∂p/∂S)V and (∂V/∂S)p in terms of the heat capacities, the expansion coefficient α, and the isothermal compressibility, κT. 3.27 Use the Maxwell relations to show that the entropy of a perfect gas depends on the volume as S ∝ R ln V. 3.28 Derive the thermodynamic equation of state T = V − T p Derive an expression for (∂H/∂p)T for (a) a perfect gas and (b) a van der Waals gas. In the latter case, estimate its value for 1.0 mol Ar(g) at 298 K and 10 atm. By how much does the enthalpy of the argon change when the pressure is increased isothermally to 11 atm? 3.29 Show that if B(T) is the second virial coefficient of a gas, and ∆B = B(T″) − B(T′), ∆T = T″ − T′, and T is the mean of T″ and T′, then πT ≈ RT2 ∆B/V2 m∆T. Estimate πT for argon given that B(250 K) = −28.0 cm3 mol−1 and B(300 K) = −15.6 cm3 mol−1 at 275 K at (a) 1.0 atm, (b) 10.0 atm. 3.30 The Joule coefficient, µJ, is defined as µJ = (∂T/∂V)U. Show that µJCV = p − αT/κT. 3.31 Evaluate πT for a Dieterici gas (Table 1.7). Justify physically the form of the expression obtained. 3.32 The adiabatic compressibility, κS, is defined like κT (eqn 2.44) but at constant entropy. Show that for a perfect gas pγκS = 1 (where γ is the ratio of heat capacities). D E F ∂V ∂T A B C D E F ∂H ∂p A B C 116 3 THE SECOND LAW 3.33 Suppose that S is regarded as a function of p and T. Show that TdS = CpdT − αTVdp. Hence, show that the energy transferred as heat when the pressure on an incompressible liquid or solid is increased by ∆p is equal to −αTV∆p. Evaluate q when the pressure acting on 100 cm3 of mercury at 0°C is increased by 1.0 kbar. (α = 1.82 × 10−4 K−1 .) 3.34 Suppose that (a) the attractive interactions between gas particles can be neglected, (b) the attractive interaction is dominant in a van der Waals gas, and the pressure is low enough to make the approximation 4ap/(RT)2 << 1. Find expressions for the fugacity of a van der Waals gas in terms of the pressure and estimate its value for ammonia at 10.00 atm and 298.15 K in each case. 3.35 Find an expression for the fugacity coefficient of a gas that obeys the equation of state pVm = RT(1 + B/Vm + C/V2 m). Use the resulting expression to estimate the fugacity of argon at 1.00 atm and 100 K using B = −21.13 cm3 mol−1 and C = 1054 cm6 mol−2 . Applications: to biology, environmental science, polymer science, and engineering 3.36 The protein lysozyme unfolds at a transition temperature of 75.5°C and the standard enthalpy of transition is 509 kJ mol−1 . Calculate the entropy of unfolding of lysozyme at 25.0°C, given that the difference in the constantpressure heat capacities upon unfolding is 6.28 kJ K−1 mol−1 and can be assumed to be independent of temperature. Hint. Imagine that the transition at 25.0°C occurs in three steps: (i) heating of the folded protein from 25.0°C to the transition temperature, (ii) unfolding at the transition temperature, and (iii) cooling of the unfolded protein to 25.0°C. Because the entropy is a state function, the entropy change at 25.0°C is equal to the sum of the entropy changes of the steps. 3.37 At 298 K the standard enthalpy of combustion of sucrose is −5797 kJ mol−1 and the standard Gibbs energy of the reaction is −6333 kJ mol−1 . Estimate the additional non-expansion work that may be obtained by raising the temperature to blood temperature, 37°C. 3.38 In biological cells, the energy released by the oxidation of foods (Impact on Biology I2.2) is stored in adenosine triphosphate (ATP or ATP4− ). The essence of ATP’s action is its ability to lose its terminal phosphate group by hydrolysis and to form adenosine diphosphate (ADP or ADP3− ): ATP4− (aq) + H2O(l) → ADP3− (aq) + HPO4 2− (aq) + H3O+ (aq) At pH = 7.0 and 37°C (310 K, blood temperature) the enthalpy and Gibbs energy of hydrolysis are ∆rH = −20 kJ mol−1 and ∆rG= −31 kJ mol−1 , respectively. Under these conditions, the hydrolysis of 1 molATP4− (aq) results in the extraction of up to 31 kJ of energy that can be used to do non-expansion work, such as the synthesis of proteins from amino acids, muscular contraction, and the activation of neuronal circuits in our brains. (a) Calculate and account for the sign of the entropy of hydrolysis of ATP at pH = 7.0 and 310 K. (b) Suppose that the radius of a typical biological cell is 10 µm and that inside it 106 ATP molecules are hydrolysed each second. What is the power density of the cell in watts per cubic metre (1 W = 1 J s−1 )? A computer battery delivers about 15 W and has a volume of 100 cm3 . Which has the greater power density, the cell or the battery? (c) The formation of glutamine from glutamate and ammonium ions requires 14.2 kJ mol−1 of energy input. It is driven by the hydrolysis of ATP to ADP mediated by the enzyme glutamine synthetase. How many moles of ATP must be hydrolysed to form 1 mol glutamine? 3.39‡ In 1995, the Intergovernmental Panel on Climate Change (IPCC) considered a global average temperature rise of 1.0–3.5°C likely by the year 2100, with 2.0°C its best estimate. Because water vapour is itself a greenhouse gas, the increase in water vapour content of the atmosphere is of some concern to climate change experts. Predict the relative increase in water vapour in the atmosphere based on a temperature rises of 2.0 K, assuming that the relative humidity remains constant. (The present global mean temperature is 290 K, and the equilibrium vapour pressure of water at that temperature is 0.0189 bar.) 3.40‡ Nitric acid hydrates have received much attention as possible catalysts for heterogeneous reactions that bring about the Antarctic ozone hole. Worsnop et al. investigated the thermodynamic stability of these hydrates under conditions typical of the polar winter stratosphere (D. R. Worsnop, L.E. Fox, M.S. Zahniser, and S.C. Wofsy, Science 259, 71 (1993)). They report thermodynamic data for the sublimation of mono-, di-, and trihydrates to nitric acid and water vapours, HNO3· nH2O (s) → HNO3(g) + nH2O(g), for n = 1, 2, and 3. Given ∆rG7 and ∆rH7 for these reactions at 220 K, use the Gibbs–Helmholtz equation to compute ∆rG7 at 190 K. n 1 2 3 ∆rG7 /(kJ mol−1 ) 46.2 69.4 93.2 ∆rH7 /(kJ mol−1 ) 127 188 237 3.41‡ J. Gao and J. H. Weiner in their study of the origin of stress on the atomic level in dense polymer systems (Science 266, 748 (1994)), observe that the tensile force required to maintain the length, l, of a long linear chain of N freely jointed links each of length a, can be interpreted as arising from an entropic spring. For such a chain, S(l) = −3kl2 /2Na2 + C, where k is the Boltzmann constant and C is a constant. Using thermodynamic relations of this and previous chapters, show that the tensile force obeys Hooke’s law, f = −kfl, if we assume that the energy U is independent of l. 3.42 Suppose that an internal combustion engine runs on octane, for which the enthalpy of combustion is −5512 kJ mol−1 and take the mass of 1 gallon of fuel as 3 kg. What is the maximum height, neglecting all forms of friction, to which a car of mass 1000 kg can be driven on 1.00 gallon of fuel given that the engine cylinder temperature is 2000°C and the exit temperature is 800°C? 3.43 The cycle involved in the operation of an internal combustion engine is called the Otto cycle. Air can be considered to be the working substance and can be assumed to be a perfect gas. The cycle consists of the following steps: (1) reversible adiabatic compression from A to B, (2) reversible constantvolume pressure increase from B to C due to the combustion of a small amount of fuel, (3) reversible adiabatic expansion from C to D, and (4) reversible and constant-volume pressure decrease back to state A. Determine the change in entropy (of the system and of the surroundings) for each step of the cycle and determine an expression for the efficiency of the cycle, assuming that the heat is supplied in Step 2. Evaluate the efficiency for a compression ratio of 10:1. Assume that, in state A, V = 4.00 dm3 , p = 1.00 atm, and T = 300 K, that VA = 10VB, pC/pB = 5, and that Cp,m = 7 –2R. 3.44 To calculate the work required to lower the temperature of an object, we need to consider how the coefficient of performance changes with the temperature of the object. (a) Find an expression for the work of cooling an object from Ti to Tf when the refrigerator is in a room at a temperature Th. Hint. Write dw = dq/c(T), relate dq to dT through the heat capacity Cp, and integrate the resulting expression. Assume that the heat capacity is independent of temperature in the range of interest. (b) Use the result in part (a) to calculate the work needed to freeze 250 g of water in a refrigerator at 293 K. How long will it take when the refrigerator operates at 100 W? 3.45 The expressions that apply to the treatment of refrigerators also describe the behaviour of heat pumps, where warmth is obtained from the back of a refrigerator while its front is being used to cool the outside world. Heat pumps are popular home heating devices because they are very efficient. Compare heating of a room at 295 K by each of two methods: (a) direct conversion of 1.00 kJ of electrical energy in an electrical heater, and (b) use of 1.00 kJ of electrical energy to run a reversible heat pump with the outside at 260 K. Discuss the origin of the difference in the energy delivered to the interior of the house by the two methods. Physical transformations of pure substances The discussion of the phase transitions of pure substances is among the simplest applications of thermodynamics to chemistry. We shall see that a phase diagram is a map of the pressures and temperatures at which each phase of a substance is the most stable. First, we describe the interpretation of empirically determined phase diagrams for a selection of materials. Then we turn to a consideration of the factors that determine the positions and shapes of the boundaries between the regions on a phase diagram. The practical importance of the expressions we derive is that they show how the vapour pressure of a substance varies with temperature and how the melting point varies with pressure. We shall see that the transitions between phases can be classified by noting how various thermodynamic functions change when the transition occurs. This chapter also introduces the chemical potential, a property that is at the centre of discussions of phase transitions and chemical reactions. Vaporization, melting, and the conversion of graphite to diamond are all examples of changes of phase without change of chemical composition. In this chapter we describe such processes thermodynamically, using as the guiding principle the tendency of systems at constant temperature and pressure to minimize their Gibbs energy. Phase diagrams One of the most succinct ways of presenting the physical changes of state that a substance can undergo is in terms of its phase diagram. We present the concept in this section. 4.1 The stabilities of phases A phase of a substance is a form of matter that is uniform throughout in chemical composition and physical state. Thus, we speak of solid, liquid, and gas phases of a substance, and of its various solid phases, such as the white and black allotropes of phosphorus. A phase transition, the spontaneous conversion of one phase into another phase, occurs at a characteristic temperature for a given pressure. Thus, at 1 atm, ice is the stable phase of water below 0°C, but above 0°C liquid water is more stable. This difference indicates that below 0°C the Gibbs energy decreases as liquid water changes into ice and that above 0°C the Gibbs energy decreases as ice changes into liquid water. The transition temperature, Ttrs, is the temperature at which the two phases are in equilibrium and the Gibbs energy is minimized at the prevailing pressure. 4 Phase diagrams 4.1 The stabilities of phases 4.2 Phase boundaries I4.1 Impact on engineering and technology: Supercritical fluids 4.3 Three typical phase diagrams Phase stability and phase transitions 4.4 The thermodynamic criterion of equilibrium 4.5 The dependence of stability on the conditions 4.6 The location of phase boundaries 4.7 The Ehrenfest classification of phase transitions Checklist of key ideas Further reading Discussion questions Exercises Problems 118 4 PHYSICAL TRANSFORMATIONS OF PURE SUBSTANCES As we stressed at the beginning of Chapter 3, we must distinguish between the thermodynamic description of a phase transition and the rate at which the transition occurs. A transition that is predicted from thermodynamics to be spontaneous may occur too slowly to be significant in practice. For instance, at normal temperatures and pressures the molar Gibbs energy of graphite is lower than that of diamond, so there is a thermodynamic tendency for diamond to change into graphite. However, for this transition to take place, the C atoms must change their locations, which is an immeasurably slow process in a solid except at high temperatures. The discussion of the rate of attainment of equilibrium is a kinetic problem and is outside the range of thermodynamics. In gases and liquids the mobilities of the molecules allow phase transitions to occur rapidly, but in solids thermodynamic instability may be frozen in. Thermodynamically unstable phases that persist because the transition is kinetically hindered are called metastable phases. Diamond is a metastable phase of carbon under normal conditions. 4.2 Phase boundaries The phase diagram of a substance shows the regions of pressure and temperature at which its various phases are thermodynamically stable (Fig. 4.1). The lines separating the regions, which are called phase boundaries, show the values of p and T at which two phases coexist in equilibrium. Consider a liquid sample of a pure substance in a closed vessel. The pressure of a vapour in equilibrium with the liquid is called the vapour pressure of the substance (Fig. 4.2). Therefore, the liquid–vapour phase boundary in a phase diagram shows how the vapour pressure of the liquid varies with temperature. Similarly, the solid– vapour phase boundary shows the temperature variation of the sublimation vapour pressure, the vapour pressure of the solid phase. The vapour pressure of a substance increases with temperature because at higher temperatures more molecules have sufficient energy to escape from their neighbours. (a) Critical points and boiling points When a liquid is heated in an open vessel, the liquid vaporizes from its surface. At the temperature at which its vapour pressure would be equal to the external pressure, vaporization can occur throughout the bulk of the liquid and the vapour can expand freely into the surroundings. The condition of free vaporization throughout the liquid is called boiling. The temperature at which the vapour pressure of a liquid is equal to the external pressure is called the boiling temperatureat that pressure. For the special case of an external pressure of 1 atm, the boiling temperature is called the normal boiling point, Tb. With the replacement of 1 atm by 1 bar as standard pressure, there is some advantage in using the standard boiling point instead: this is the temperature at which the vapour pressure reaches 1 bar. Because 1 bar is slightly less than 1 atm (1.00 bar = 0.987 atm), the standard boiling point of a liquid is slightly lower than its normal boiling point. The normal boiling point of water is 100.0°C; its standard boiling point is 99.6°C. Boiling does not occur when a liquid is heated in a rigid, closed vessel. Instead, the vapour pressure, and hence the density of the vapour, rise as the temperature is raised (Fig. 4.3). At the same time, the density of the liquid decreases slightly as a result of its expansion. There comes a stage when the density of the vapour is equal to that of the remaining liquid and the surface between the two phases disappears. The temperature at which the surface disappears is the critical temperature, Tc, of the substance. We first encountered this property in Section 1.3d. The vapour pressure at the critical temperature is called the critical pressure, pc. At and above the critical temperature, a single uniform phase called a supercritical fluid fills the container and an interface no Solid Liquid Vapour Triple point Pressure,p Temperature, T TcT3 Critical point Fig. 4.1 The general regions of pressure and temperature where solid, liquid, or gas is stable (that is, has minimum molar Gibbs energy) are shown on this phase diagram. For example, the solid phase is the most stable phase at low temperatures and high pressures. In the following paragraphs we locate the precise boundaries between the regions. Liquid or solid Vapour, pressure, p Fig. 4.2 The vapour pressure of a liquid or solid is the pressure exerted by the vapour in equilibrium with the condensed phase. Comment 4.1 The NIST Chemistry WebBook is a good source of links to online databases of data on phase transitions. 4.2 PHASE BOUNDARIES 119 longer exists. That is, above the critical temperature, the liquid phase of the substance does not exist. (b) Melting points and triple points The temperature at which, under a specified pressure, the liquid and solid phases of a substance coexist in equilibrium is called the melting temperature. Because a substance melts at exactly the same temperature as it freezes, the melting temperature of a substance is the same as its freezing temperature. The freezing temperature when the pressure is 1 atm is called the normal freezing point, Tf, and its freezing point when the pressure is 1 bar is called the standardfreezingpoint. The normal and standard freezing points are negligibly different for most purposes. The normal freezing point is also called the normal melting point. There is a set of conditions under which three different phases of a substance (typically solid, liquid, and vapour) all simultaneously coexist in equilibrium. These conditions are represented by the triple point, a point at which the three phase boundaries meet. The temperature at the triple point is denoted T3. The triple point of a pure substance is outside our control: it occurs at a single definite pressure and temperature characteristic of the substance. The triple point of water lies at 273.16 K and 611 Pa (6.11 mbar, 4.58 Torr), and the three phases of water (ice, liquid water, and water vapour) coexist in equilibrium at no other combination of pressure and temperature. This invariance of the triple point is the basis of its use in the definition of the thermodynamic temperature scale (Section 3.2c). As we can see from Fig. 4.1, the triple point marks the lowest pressure at which a liquid phase of a substance can exist. If (as is common) the slope of the solid–liquid phase boundary is as shown in the diagram, then the triple point also marks the lowest temperature at which the liquid can exist; the critical temperature is the upper limit. IMPACT ON CHEMICAL ENGINEERING AND TECHNOLOGY I4.1 Supercritical fluids Supercritical carbon dioxide, scCO2, is the centre of attention for an increasing number of solvent-based processes. The critical temperature of CO2, 304.2 K (31.0°C) and its critical pressure, 72.9 atm, are readily accessible, it is cheap, and it can readily be recycled. The density of scCO2 at its critical point is 0.45 g cm−3 . However, the transport properties of any supercritical fluid depend strongly on its density, which in turn is sensitive to the pressure and temperature. For instance, densities may be adjusted from a gas-like 0.1 g cm−3 to a liquid-like 1.2 g cm−3 . A useful rule of thumb is that the solubility of a solute is an exponential function of the density of the supercritical fluid, so small increases in pressure, particularly close to the critical point, can have very large effects on solubility. A great advantage of scCO2 is that there are no noxious residues once the solvent has been allowed to evaporate, so, coupled with its low critical temperature, scCO2 is ideally suited to food processing and the production of pharmaceuticals. It is used, for instance, to remove caffeine from coffee. The supercritical fluid is also increasingly being used for dry cleaning, which avoids the use of carcinogenic and environmentally deleterious chlorinated hydrocarbons. Supercritical CO2 has been used since the 1960s as a mobile phase in supercritical fluid chromatography (SFC), but it fell out of favour when the more convenient technique of high-performance liquid chromatography (HPLC) was introduced. However, interest in SFC has returned, and there are separations possible in SFC that cannot easily be achieved by HPLC, such as the separation of lipids and of phospholipids. Samples as small as 1 pg can be analysed. The essential advantage of SFC is that diffusion coefficients in supercritical fluids are an order of magnitude greater than in (a) (b) (c) Fig. 4.3 (a) A liquid in equilibrium with its vapour. (b) When a liquid is heated in a sealed container, the density of the vapour phase increases and that of the liquid decreases slightly. There comes a stage, (c), at which the two densities are equal and the interface between the fluids disappears. This disappearance occurs at the critical temperature. The container needs to be strong: the critical temperature of water is 374°C and the vapour pressure is then 218 atm. 120 4 PHYSICAL TRANSFORMATIONS OF PURE SUBSTANCES liquids, so there is less resistance to the transfer of solutes through the column, with the result that separations may be effected rapidly or with high resolution. The principal problem with scCO2, though, is that the fluid is not a very good solvent and surfactants are needed to induce many potentially interesting solutes to dissolve. Indeed, scCO2-based dry cleaning depends on the availability of cheap surfactants; so too does the use of scCO2 as a solvent for homogeneous catalysts, such as metal complexes. There appear to be two principal approaches to solving the solubilization problem. One solution is to use fluorinated and siloxane-based polymeric stabilizers, which allow polymerization reactions to proceed in scCO2. The disadvantage of these stabilizers for commercial use is their great expense. An alternative and much cheaper approach is poly(ether-carbonate) copolymers. The copolymers can be made more soluble in scCO2 by adjusting the ratio of ether and carbonate groups. The critical temperature of water is 374°C and its pressure is 218 atm. The conditions for using scH2O are therefore much more demanding than for scCO2 and the properties of the fluid are highly sensitive to pressure. Thus, as the density of scH2O decreases, the characteristics of a solution change from those of an aqueous solution through those of a non-aqueous solution and eventually to those of a gaseous solution. One consequence is that reaction mechanisms may change from those involving ions to those involving radicals. 4.3 Three typical phase diagrams We shall now see how these general features appear in the phase diagrams of pure substances. (a) Carbon dioxide The phase diagram for carbon dioxide is shown in Fig. 4.4. The features to notice include the positive slope of the solid–liquid boundary (the direction of this line is characteristic of most substances), which indicates that the melting temperature of solid carbon dioxide rises as the pressure is increased. Notice also that, as the triple point lies above 1 atm, the liquid cannot exist at normal atmospheric pressures whatever the temperature, and the solid sublimes when left in the open (hence the name ‘dry ice’). To obtain the liquid, it is necessary to exert a pressure of at least 5.11 atm. Cylinders of carbon dioxide generally contain the liquid or compressed gas; at 25°C that implies a vapour pressure of 67 atm if both gas and liquid are present in equilibrium. When the gas squirts through the throttle it cools by the Joule–Thomson effect, so when it emerges into a region where the pressure is only 1 atm, it condenses into a finely divided snow-like solid. (b) Water Figure 4.5 is the phase diagram for water. The liquid–vapour boundary in the phase diagram summarizes how the vapour pressure of liquid water varies with temperature. It also summarizes how the boiling temperature varies with pressure: we simply read off the temperature at which the vapour pressure is equal to the prevailing atmospheric pressure. The solid–liquid boundary shows how the melting temperature varies with the pressure. Its very steep slope indicates that enormous pressures are needed to bring about significant changes. Notice that the line has a negative slope up to 2 kbar, which means that the melting temperature falls as the pressure is raised. The reason for this almost unique behaviour can be traced to the decrease in volume that occurs on melting, and hence it being more favourable for the solid to transform into the liquid as the pressure is raised. The decrease in volume is a result of the very Fig. 4.4 The experimental phase diagram for carbon dioxide. Note that, as the triple point lies at pressures well above atmospheric, liquid carbon dioxide does not exist under normal conditions (a pressure of at least 5.11 atm must be applied). 4.3 THREE TYPICAL PHASE DIAGRAMS 121 open molecular structure of ice: as shown in Fig 4.6, the water molecules are held apart, as well as together, by the hydrogen bonds between them but the structure partially collapses on melting and the liquid is denser than the solid. Figure 4.5 shows that water has one liquid phase but many different solid phases other than ordinary ice (‘ice I’, shown in Fig. 4.5). Some of these phases melt at high temperatures. Ice VII, for instance, melts at 100°C but exists only above 25 kbar. Note that five more triple points occur in the diagram other than the one where vapour, liquid, and ice I coexist. Each one occurs at a definite pressure and temperature that cannot be changed. The solid phases of ice differ in the arrangement of the water molecules: under the influence of very high pressures, hydrogen bonds buckle and the H2O molecules adopt different arrangements. These polymorphs, or different solid phases, of ice may be responsible for the advance of glaciers, for ice at the bottom of glaciers experiences very high pressures where it rests on jagged rocks. (c) Helium Figure 4.7 shows the phase diagram of helium. Helium behaves unusually at low temperatures. For instance, the solid and gas phases of helium are never in equilibrium however low the temperature: the atoms are so light that they vibrate with a largeamplitude motion even at very low temperatures and the solid simply shakes itself apart. Solid helium can be obtained, but only by holding the atoms together by applying pressure. When considering helium at low temperatures it is necessary to distinguish between the isotopes 3 He and 4 He. Pure helium-4 has two liquid phases. The phase marked He-I in the diagram behaves like a normal liquid; the other phase, He-II, is a superfluid; 0 200 400 600 800 1 103 106 10 9 10 12 XI X VIII VII VI VII I III Vapour Liquid Pressure,/Pap Temperature, /KT Fig. 4.5 The experimental phase diagram for water showing the different solid phases. Fig. 4.6 A fragment of the structure of ice (ice-I). Each O atom is linked by two covalent bonds to H atoms and by two hydrogen bonds to a neighbouring O atom, in a tetrahedral array. 0.1 0.01 1 10 100 p/bar 1 2 3 4 5 2.17 4.22 5.20 ( )Tl ( )Tb ( )Tc Temperature, /KT Triple point Solid (hcp) (bcc) Liquid He-II (superfluid) Liquid He-I Gas Critical point l-line Fig. 4.7 The phase diagram for helium (4 He). The λ-line marks the conditions under which the two liquid phases are in equilibrium. Helium-II is the superfluid phase. Note that a pressure of over 20 bar must be exerted before solid helium can be obtained. The labels hcp and bcc denote different solid phases in which the atoms pack together differently: hcp denotes hexagonal closed packing and bcc denotes body-centred cubic (see Section 20.1 for a description of these structures). 122 4 PHYSICAL TRANSFORMATIONS OF PURE SUBSTANCES it is so called because it flows without viscosity.1 Provided we discount the liquid crystalline substances discussed in Section 6.6, helium is the only known substance with a liquid–liquid boundary, shown as the λ-line (lambda line) in Fig. 4.7. The phase diagram of helium-3 differs from the phase diagram of helium-4, but it also possesses a superfluid phase. Helium-3 is unusual in that the entropy of the liquid is lower than that of the solid, and melting is exothermic. Phase stability and phase transitions We shall now see how thermodynamic considerations can account for the features of the phase diagrams we have just described. All our considerations will be based on the Gibbs energy of a substance, and in particular on its molar Gibbs energy, Gm. In fact, this quantity will play such an important role in this chapter and the rest of the text that we give it a special name and symbol, the chemical potential, µ (mu). For a onecomponent system, ‘molar Gibbs energy’ and ‘chemical potential’ are synonyms, so µ = Gm, but in Chapter 5 we shall see that chemical potential has a broader significance and a more general definition. The name ‘chemical potential’ is also instructive: as we develop the concept, we shall see that µ is a measure of the potential that a substance has for undergoing change in a system. In this chapter, it reflects the potential of a substance to undergo physical change. In Chapter 7 we shall see that µ is the potential of a substance to undergo chemical change. 4.4 The thermodynamic criterion of equilibrium WebaseourdiscussiononthefollowingconsequenceoftheSecondLaw:atequilibrium, thechemicalpotentialofasubstanceisthesamethroughoutasample,regardlessofhowmany phases are present. When the liquid and solid phases of a substance are in equilibrium, the chemical potential of the substance is the same throughout the system (Fig. 4.8). To see the validity of this remark, consider a system in which the chemical potential of a substance is µ1 at one location and µ2 at another location. The locations may be in the same or in different phases. When an amount dn of the substance is transferred from one location to the other, the Gibbs energy of the system changes by −µ1dn when material is removed from location 1, and it changes by +µ2dn when that material is added to location 2. The overall change is therefore dG = (µ2 − µ1)dn. If the chemical potential at location 1 is higher than that at location 2, the transfer is accompanied by a decrease in G, and so has a spontaneous tendency to occur. Only if µ1 = µ2 is there no change in G, and only then is the system at equilibrium. We conclude that the transition temperature, Ttrs, is the temperature at which the chemical potentials of two phases are equal. 4.5 The dependence of stability on the conditions At low temperatures and provided the pressure is not too low, the solid phase of a substance has the lowest chemical potential and is therefore the most stable phase. However, the chemical potentials of different phases change with temperature in different ways, and above a certain temperature the chemical potential of another phase (perhaps another solid phase, a liquid, or a gas) may turn out to be the lowest. When that happens, a transition to the second phase is spontaneous and occurs if it is kinetically feasible to do so. Same chemical potential Fig. 4.8 When two or more phases are in equilibrium, the chemical potential of a substance (and, in a mixture, a component) is the same in each phase and is the same at all points in each phase. 1 Recent work has suggested that water may also have a superfluid liquid phase. 4.5 THE DEPENDENCE OF STABILITY ON THE CONDITIONS 123 Solid Liquid Gas Solid stable Liquid stable Gas stable Temperature, T Chemicalpotential, Tf Tb m Fig. 4.9 The schematic temperature dependence of the chemical potential of the solid, liquid, and gas phases of a substance (in practice, the lines are curved). The phase with the lowest chemical potential at a specified temperature is the most stable one at that temperature. The transition temperatures, the melting and boiling temperatures (Tf and Tb, respectively), are the temperatures at which the chemical potentials of the two phases are equal. (a) The temperature dependence of phase stability The temperature dependence of the Gibbs energy is expressed in terms of the entropy of the system by eqn 3.50 ((∂G/∂T)p = −S). Because the chemical potential of a pure substance is just another name for its molar Gibbs energy, it follows that p = −Sm (4.1) This relation shows that, as the temperature is raised, the chemical potential of a pure substance decreases: Sm > 0 for all substances, so the slope of a plot of µ against T is negative. Equation 4.1 implies that the slope of a plot of µ against temperature is steeper for gases than for liquids, because Sm(g) > Sm(l). The slope is also steeper for a liquid than the corresponding solid, because Sm(l) > Sm(s) almost always. These features are illustrated in Fig. 4.9. The steep negative slope of µ(l) results in its falling below µ(s) when the temperature is high enough, and then the liquid becomes the stable phase: the solid melts. The chemical potential of the gas phase plunges steeply downwards as the temperature is raised (because the molar entropy of the vapour is so high), and there comes a temperature at which it lies lowest. Then the gas is the stable phase and vaporization is spontaneous. (b) The response of melting to applied pressure Most substances melt at a higher temperature when subjected to pressure. It is as though the pressure is preventing the formation of the less dense liquid phase. Exceptions to this behaviour include water, for which the liquid is denser than the solid. Application of pressure to water encourages the formation of the liquid phase. That is, water freezes at a lower temperature when it is under pressure. We can rationalize the response of melting temperatures to pressure as follows. The variation of the chemical potential with pressure is expressed (from the second of eqn 3.50) by T = Vm (4.2) This equation shows that the slope of a plot of chemical potential against pressure is equal to the molar volume of the substance. An increase in pressure raises the chemical potential of any pure substance (because Vm > 0). In most cases, Vm(l) > Vm(s) and the equation predicts that an increase in pressure increases the chemical potential of the liquid more than that of the solid. As shown in Fig. 4.10a, the effect of pressure in such D F ∂µ ∂p A C D F ∂µ ∂T A C Chemicalpotential, Tf Tf´ Temperature, T (a) High pressure Low pressure m TfTf´ Temperature, T (b) High pressure Low pressure Chemicalpotential,m Fig. 4.10 The pressure dependence of the chemical potential of a substance depends on the molar volume of the phase. The lines show schematically the effect of increasing pressure on the chemical potential of the solid and liquid phases (in practice, the lines are curved), and the corresponding effects on the freezing temperatures. (a) In this case the molar volume of the solid is smaller than that of the liquid and µ(s) increases less than µ(l). As a result, the freezing temperature rises. (b) Here the molar volume is greater for the solid than the liquid (as for water), µ(s) increases more strongly than µ(l), and the freezing temperature is lowered. 124 4 PHYSICAL TRANSFORMATIONS OF PURE SUBSTANCES a case is to raise the melting temperature slightly. For water, however, Vm(l) < Vm(s), and an increase in pressure increases the chemical potential of the solid more than that of the liquid. In this case, the melting temperature is lowered slightly (Fig. 4.10b). Example 4.1 Assessing the effect of pressure on the chemical potential Calculate the effect on the chemical potentials of ice and water of increasing the pressure from 1.00 bar to 2.00 bar at 0°C. The density of ice is 0.917 g cm−3 and that of liquid water is 0.999 g cm−3 under these conditions. Method From eqn 4.2, we know that the change in chemical potential of an incompressible substance when the pressure is changed by ∆p is ∆µ = Vm∆p. Therefore, to answer the question, we need to know the molar volumes of the two phases of water. These values are obtained from the mass density, ρ, and the molar mass, M, by using Vm = M/ρ. We therefore use the expression ∆µ = M∆p/ρ. Answer The molar mass of water is 18.02 g mol−1 (1.802 × 10−2 kg mol−1 ); therefore, ∆µ(ice) = = +1.97 J mol−1 ∆µ(water) = = +1.80 J mol−1 We interpret the numerical results as follows: the chemical potential of ice rises more sharply than that of water, so if they are initially in equilibrium at 1 bar, then there will be a tendency for the ice to melt at 2 bar. Self-test 4.1 Calculate the effect of an increase in pressure of 1.00 bar on the liquid and solid phases of carbon dioxide (of molar mass 44.0 g mol−1 ) in equilibrium with densities 2.35 g cm−3 and 2.50 g cm−3 , respectively. [∆µ(l) = +1.87 J mol−1 , ∆µ(s) = +1.76 J mol−1 ; solid forms] (c) The effect of applied pressure on vapour pressure When pressure is applied to a condensed phase, its vapour pressure rises: in effect, molecules are squeezed out of the phase and escape as a gas. Pressure can be exerted on the condensed phases mechanically or by subjecting it to the applied pressure of an inert gas (Fig. 4.11); in the latter case, the vapour pressure is the partial pressure of the vapour in equilibrium with the condensed phase, and we speak of the partial vapour pressure of the substance. One complication (which we ignore here) is that, if the condensed phase is a liquid, then the pressurizing gas might dissolve and change the properties of the liquid. Another complication is that the gas phase molecules might attract molecules out of the liquid by the process of gas solvation, the attachment of molecules to gas phase species. As shown in the following Justification, the quantitative relation between the vapour pressure, p, when a pressure ∆P is applied and the vapour pressure, p*, of the liquid in the absence of an additional pressure is p = p*eVm(l)∆P/RT (4.3) This equation shows how the vapour pressure increases when the pressure acting on the condensed phase is increased. (1.802 × 10−2 kg mol−1 ) × (1.00 × 105 Pa) 999 kg m−3 (1.802 × 10−2 kg mol−1 ) × (1.00 × 105 Pa) 917 kg m−3 Piston permeable to vapour but not to liquid Pressure, DP (a) (b) Vapour plus inert pressurizing gas Fig. 4.11 Pressure may be applied to a condensed phases either (a) by compressing the condensed phase or (b) by subjecting it to an inert pressurizing gas. When pressure is applied, the vapour pressure of the condensed phase increases. 4.5 THE DEPENDENCE OF STABILITY ON THE CONDITIONS 125 Justification 4.1 The vapour pressure of a pressurized liquid We calculate the vapour pressure of a pressurized liquid by using the fact that at equilibrium the chemical potentials of the liquid and its vapour are equal: µ(l) = µ(g). It follows that, for any change that preserves equilibrium, the resulting change in µ(l) must be equal to the change in µ(g); therefore, we can write dµ(g) = dµ(l). When the pressure P on the liquid is increased by dP, the chemical potential of the liquid changes by dµ(l) = Vm(l)dP. The chemical potential of the vapour changes by dµ(g) = Vm(g)dp where dp is the change in the vapour pressure we are trying to find. If we treat the vapour as a perfect gas, the molar volume can be replaced by Vm(g) = RT/p, and we obtain dµ(g) = Next, we equate the changes in chemical potentials of the vapour and the liquid: = Vm(l)dP We can integrate this expression once we know the limits of integration. When there is no additional pressure acting on the liquid, P (the pressure experienced by the liquid) is equal to the normal vapour pressure p*, so when P = p*, p = p* too. When there is an additional pressure ∆P on the liquid, with the result that P = p + ∆P, the vapour pressure is p (the value we want to find). Provided the effect of pressure on the vapour pressure is small (as will turn out to be the case) a good approximation is to replace the p in p + ∆P by p* itself, and to set the upper limit of the integral to p* + ∆P. The integrations required are therefore as follows: RTΎ p p* = Ύ p*+∆P p* Vm(l)dP We now divide both sides by RT and assume that the molar volume of the liquid is the same throughout the small range of pressures involved: Ύ p p* = Ύ p*+∆P p* dP Then both integrations are straightforward, and lead to ln = ∆P which rearranges to eqn 4.3 because eln x = x. Illustration 4.1 The effect of applied pressure on the vapour pressure of liquid water For water, which has density 0.997 g cm−3 at 25°C and therefore molar volume 18.1 cm3 mol−1 , when the pressure is increased by 10 bar (that is, ∆P = 1.0 × 105 Pa) = = where we have used 1 J = 1 Pa m3 . It follows that p = 1.0073p*, an increase of 0.73 per cent. Self-test 4.2 Calculate the effect of an increase in pressure of 100 bar on the vapour pressure of benzene at 25°C, which has density 0.879 g cm−3 . [43 per cent] 1.81 × 1.0 × 10 8.3145 × 298 (1.81 × 10−5 m3 mol−1 ) × (1.0 × 106 Pa) (8.3145 J K−1 mol−1 ) × (298 K) Vm(l)∆P RT Vm(l) RT p p* Vm(l) RT dp p dp p RTdp p RTdp p 126 4 PHYSICAL TRANSFORMATIONS OF PURE SUBSTANCES Pressure,p Temperature, T Phase b Phase a dT dp a b Fig. 4.12 When pressure is applied to a system in which two phases are in equilibrium (at a), the equilibrium is disturbed. It can be restored by changing the temperature, so moving the state of the system to b. It follows that there is a relation between dp and dT that ensures that the system remains in equilibrium as either variable is changed. Pressure,p Temperature, T Solid Liquid Fig. 4.13 A typical solid–liquid phase boundary slopes steeply upwards. This slope implies that, as the pressure is raised, the melting temperature rises. Most substances behave in this way. 4.6 The location of phase boundaries We can find the precise locations of the phase boundaries—the pressures and temperatures at which two phases can coexist—by making use of the fact that, when two phases are in equilibrium, their chemical potentials must be equal. Therefore, where the phases α and β are in equilibrium, µα(p,T) = µβ(p,T) (4.4) By solving this equation for p in terms of T, we get an equation for the phase boundary. (a) The slopes of the phase boundaries It turns out to be simplest to discuss the phase boundaries in terms of their slopes, dp/dT. Let p and T be changed infinitesimally, but in such a way that the two phases α and β remain in equilibrium. The chemical potentials of the phases are initially equal (the two phases are in equilibrium). They remain equal when the conditions are changed to another point on the phase boundary, where the two phases continue to be in equilibrium (Fig. 4.12). Therefore, the changes in the chemical potentials of the two phases must be equal and we can write dµα = dµβ. Because, from eqn 3.49 (dG = Vdp − SdT), we know that dµ = −SmdT + Vmdp for each phase, it follows that −Sα,mdT + Vα,mdp = −Sβ,mdT + Vβ,mdp where Sα,m and Sβ,m are the molar entropies of the phases and Vα,m and Vβ,m are their molar volumes. Hence (Vβ,m − Vα,m)dp = (Sβ,m − Sα,m)dT (4.5) which rearranges into the Clapeyron equation: = (4.6) In this expression ∆trsS = Sβ,m − Sα,m and ∆trsV = Vβ,m − Vα,m are the entropy and volume of transition, respectively. The Clapeyron equation is an exact expression for the slope of the phase boundary and applies to any phase equilibrium of any pure substance. It implies that we can use thermodynamic data to predict the appearance of phase diagrams and to understand their form. A more practical application is to the prediction of the response of freezing and boiling points to the application of pressure. (b) The solid–liquid boundary Melting (fusion) is accompanied by a molar enthalpy change ∆fusH and occurs at a temperature T. The molar entropy of melting at T is therefore ∆fusH/T (Section 3.3), and the Clapeyron equation becomes = (4.7) where ∆fusV is the change in molar volume that occurs on melting. The enthalpy of melting is positive (the only exception is helium-3) and the volume change is usually positive and always small. Consequently, the slope dp/dT is steep and usually positive (Fig. 4.13). We can obtain the formula for the phase boundary by integrating dp/dT, assuming that ∆fusH and ∆fusV change so little with temperature and pressure that they can be treated as constant. If the melting temperature is T* when the pressure is p*, and T when the pressure is p, the integration required is ∆fusH T∆fusV dp dT ∆trsS ∆trsV dp dT 4.6 THE LOCATION OF PHASE BOUNDARIES 127 Comment 4.2 Calculations involving natural logarithms often become simpler if we note that, provided −1 < x < 1, ln(1 + x) = x − 1–2x2 + 1–3x3 · · · . If x << 1, a good approximation is ln(1 + x) ≈ x. Ύ p p* dp = Ύ T T* Therefore, the approximate equation of the solid–liquid boundary is p ≈ p* + ln (4.8) This equation was originally obtained by yet another Thomson—James, the brother of William, Lord Kelvin. When T is close to T*, the logarithm can be approximated by using ln = ln 1 + ≈ therefore, p ≈ p* + (T − T*) (4.9) This expression is the equation of a steep straight line when p is plotted against T (as in Fig. 4.13). (c) The liquid–vapour boundary The entropy of vaporization at a temperature T is equal to ∆vapH/T; the Clapeyron equation for the liquid–vapour boundary is therefore = (4.10) The enthalpy of vaporization is positive; ∆vapV is large and positive. Therefore, dp/dT is positive, but it is much smaller than for the solid–liquid boundary. It follows that dT/dp is large, and hence that the boiling temperature is more responsive to pressure than the freezing temperature. Example 4.2 Estimating the effect of pressure on the boiling temperature Estimate the typical size of the effect of increasing pressure on the boiling point of a liquid. Method To use eqn 4.10 we need to estimate the right-hand side. At the boiling point, the term ∆vapH/T is Trouton’s constant (Section 3.3b). Because the molar volume of a gas is so much greater than the molar volume of a liquid, we can write ∆vapV = Vm(g) − Vm(l) ≈ Vm(g) and take for Vm(g) the molar volume of a perfect gas (at low pressures, at least). Answer Trouton’s constant has the value 85 J K−1 mol−1 . The molar volume of a perfect gas is about 25 dm3 mol−1 at 1 atm and near but above room temperature. Therefore, ≈ = 3.4 × 103 Pa K−1 85 J K−1 mol−1 2.5 × 10−2 m3 mol−1 dp dT ∆vapH T∆vapV dp dT ∆fusH T*∆fusV T − T* T* D F T − T* T* A C T T* T T* ∆fusH ∆fusV dT T ∆fusH ∆fusV 128 4 PHYSICAL TRANSFORMATIONS OF PURE SUBSTANCES Pressure,p Temperature, T Liquid Gas Fig. 4.14 A typical liquid–vapour phase boundary. The boundary can be regarded as a plot of the vapour pressure against the temperature. Note that, in some depictions of phase diagrams in which a logarithmic pressure scale is used, the phase boundary has the opposite curvature (see Fig. 4.7). This phase boundary terminates at the critical point (not shown). We have used 1 J = 1 Pa m3 . This value corresponds to 0.034 atm K−1 , and hence to dT/dp = 29 K atm−1 . Therefore, a change of pressure of +0.1 atm can be expected to change a boiling temperature by about +3 K. Self-test 4.3 Estimate dT/dp for water at its normal boiling point using the information in Table 3.2 and Vm(g) = RT/p. [28 K atm−1 ] Because the molar volume of a gas is so much greater than the molar volume of a liquid, we can write ∆vapV ≈ Vm(g) (as in Example 4.2). Moreover, if the gas behaves perfectly, Vm(g) = RT/p. These two approximations turn the exact Clapeyron equation into = which rearranges into the Clausius–Clapeyron equation for the variation of vapour pressure with temperature: = (4.11)° (We have used dx/x = d ln x.) Like the Clapeyron equation, the Clausius–Clapeyron equation is important for understanding the appearance of phase diagrams, particularly the location and shape of the liquid–vapour and solid–vapour phase boundaries. It lets us predict how the vapour pressure varies with temperature and how the boiling temperature varies with pressure. For instance, if we also assume that the enthalpy of vaporization is independent of temperature, this equation can be integrated as follows: Ύ ln p ln p* d ln p = Ύ T T* = − − where p* is the vapour pressure when the temperature is T* and p the vapour pressure when the temperature is T. Therefore, because the integral on the left evaluates to ln(p/p*), the two vapour pressures are related by p = p*e−χ χ = − (4.12)° Equation 4.12 is plotted as the liquid–vapour boundary in Fig. 4.14. The line does not extend beyond the critical temperature Tc, because above this temperature the liquid does not exist. Illustration 4.2 The effect of temperature on the vapour pressure of a liquid Equation 4.12 can be used to estimate the vapour pressure of a liquid at any temperature from its normal boiling point, the temperature at which the vapour pressure is 1.00 atm (101 kPa). Thus, because the normal boiling point of benzene is 80°C (353 K) and (from Table 2.3), ∆vapH7 = 30.8 kJ mol−1 , to calculate the vapour pressure at 20°C (293 K), we write χ = − = − D F 1 353 1 293 A C 3.08 × 104 8.3145 D F 1 353 K 1 293 K A C 3.08 × 104 J mol−1 8.3145 J K−1 mol−1 D F 1 T* 1 T A C ∆vapH R D F 1 T* 1 T A C ∆vapH R dT T2 ∆vapH R ∆vapH RT2 d ln p dT ∆vapH T(RT/p) dp dT 4.7 THE EHRENFEST CLASSIFICATION OF PHASE TRANSITIONS 129 Pressure,p Temperature, T Gas Solid Liquid Fig. 4.15 Near the point where they coincide (at the triple point), the solid–gas boundary has a steeper slope than the liquid–gas boundary because the enthalpy of sublimation is greater than the enthalpy of vaporization and the temperatures that occur in the Clausius–Clapeyron equation for the slope have similar values. and substitute this value into eqn 4.12 with p* = 101 kPa. The result is 12 kPa. The experimental value is 10 kPa. A note on good practice Because exponential functions are so sensitive, it is good practice to carry out numerical calculations like this without evaluating the intermediate steps and using rounded values. (d) The solid–vapour boundary The only difference between this case and the last is the replacement of the enthalpy of vaporization by the enthalpy of sublimation, ∆subH. Because the enthalpy of sublimation is greater than the enthalpy of vaporization (∆subH = ∆fusH + ∆vapH), the equation predicts a steeper slope for the sublimation curve than for the vaporization curve at similar temperatures, which is near where they meet at the triple point (Fig. 4.15). 4.7 The Ehrenfest classification of phase transitions There are many different types of phase transition, including the familiar examples of fusion and vaporization and the less familiar examples of solid–solid, conducting– superconducting, and fluid–superfluid transitions. We shall now see that it is possible to use thermodynamic properties of substances, and in particular the behaviour of the chemical potential, to classify phase transitions into different types. The classification scheme was originally proposed by Paul Ehrenfest, and is known as the Ehrenfest classification. Many familiar phase transitions, like fusion and vaporization, are accompanied by changes of enthalpy and volume. These changes have implications for the slopes of the chemical potentials of the phases at either side of the phase transition. Thus, at the transition from a phase α to another phase β, T − T = Vβ,m − Vα,m = ∆trsV p − p = −Sβ,m + Sα,m = ∆trsS = (4.13) Because ∆trsV and ∆trsH are non-zero for melting and vaporization, it follows that for such transitions the slopes of the chemical potential plotted against either pressure or temperature are different on either side of the transition (Fig. 4.16a). In other words, the first derivatives of the chemical potentials with respect to pressure and temperature are discontinuous at the transition. A transition for which the first derivative of the chemical potential with respect to temperature is discontinuous is classified as a first-order phase transition. The constant-pressure heat capacity, Cp, of a substance is the slope of a plot of the enthalpy with respect to temperature. At a first-order phase transition, H changes by a finite amount for an infinitesimal change of temperature. Therefore, at the transition the heat capacity is infinite. The physical reason is that heating drives the transition rather than raising the temperature. For example, boiling water stays at the same temperature even though heat is being supplied. ∆trsH Ttrs D F ∂µα ∂T A C D F ∂µβ ∂T A C D F ∂µα ∂p A C D F ∂µβ ∂p A C 130 4 PHYSICAL TRANSFORMATIONS OF PURE SUBSTANCES 2 A metallic conductor is a substance with an electrical conductivity that decreases as the temperature increases. A superconductor is a solid that conducts electricity without resistance. See Chapter 20 for more details. A second-order phase transition in the Ehrenfest sense is one in which the first derivative of µ with respect to temperature is continuous but its second derivative is discontinuous. A continuous slope of µ (a graph with the same slope on either side of the transition) implies that the volume and entropy (and hence the enthalpy) do not change at the transition (Fig. 4.16b). The heat capacity is discontinuous at the transition but does not become infinite there. An example of a second-order transition is the conducting–superconducting transition in metals at low temperatures.2 The term λ-transition is applied to a phase transition that is not first-order yet the heat capacity becomes infinite at the transition temperature. Typically, the heat capacity of a system that shows such a transition begins to increase well before the transition (Fig. 4.17), and the shape of the heat capacity curve resembles the Greek letter lambda. This type of transition includes order–disorder transitions in alloys, the onset of ferromagnetism, and the fluid–superfluid transition of liquid helium. Molecular interpretation 4.1 Second-order phase transitions and λ-transitions One type of second-order transition is associated with a change in symmetry of the crystal structure of a solid. Thus, suppose the arrangement of atoms in a solid is like that represented in Fig. 4.18a, with one dimension (technically, of the unit cell) longer than the other two, which are equal. Such a crystal structure is classified as tetragonal (see Section 20.1). Moreover, suppose the two shorter dimensions increase more than the long dimension when the temperature is raised. There may come a stage when the three dimensions become equal. At that point the crystal has cubic symmetry (Fig. 4.18b), and at higher temperatures it will expand equally in all three directions (because there is no longer any distinction between them). The tetragonal → cubic phase transition has occurred, but as it has not involved a discontinuity in the interaction energy between the atoms or the volume they occupy, the transition is not first-order. Fig. 4.17 The λ-curve for helium, where the heat capacity rises to infinity. The shape of this curve is the origin of the name λ- transition. Volume, V Enthalpy, H Chemical potential, Entropy, S Heat capacity, Cp Temperature, T (a) (b) m Fig. 4.16 The changes in thermodynamic properties accompanying (a) first-order and (b) second-order phase transitions. CHECKLIST OF KEY IDEAS 131 The order–disorder transition in β-brass (CuZn) is an example of a λ-transition. The low-temperature phase is an orderly array of alternating Cu and Zn atoms. The high-temperature phase is a random array of the atoms (Fig. 4.19). At T = 0 the order is perfect, but islands of disorder appear as the temperature is raised. The islands form because the transition is cooperative in the sense that, once two atoms have exchanged locations, it is easier for their neighbours to exchange their locations. The islands grow in extent, and merge throughout the crystal at the transition temperature (742 K). The heat capacity increases as the transition temperature is approached because the cooperative nature of the transition means that it is increasingly easy for the heat supplied to drive the phase transition rather than to be stored as thermal motion. (a) (b) (c) Equal rates Equal rates Equal rates Cubic phase Phase transition (b) Fig. 4.18 One version of a second-order phase transition in which (a) a tetragonal phase expands more rapidly in two directions than a third, and hence becomes a cubic phase, which (b) expands uniformly in three directions as the temperature is raised. There is no rearrangement of atoms at the transition temperature, and hence no enthalpy of transition. Fig. 4.19 An order–disorder transition. (a) At T = 0, there is perfect order, with different kinds of atoms occupying alternate sites. (b) As the temperature is increased, atoms exchange locations and islands of each kind of atom form in regions of the solid. Some of the original order survives. (c) At and above the transition temperature, the islands occur at random throughout the sample. Slow Fast Fast Tetragonal phase (a) Checklist of key ideas 1. A phase is a form of matter that is uniform throughout in chemical composition and physical state. 2. A transition temperature is the temperature at which the two phases are in equilibrium. 3. A metastable phase is a thermodynamically unstable phase that persists because the transition is kinetically hindered. 4. A phase diagram is a diagram showing the regions of pressure and temperature at which its various phases are thermodynamically stable. 5. A phase boundary is a line separating the regions in a phase diagram showing the values of p and T at which two phases coexist in equilibrium. 6. The vapour pressure is the pressure of a vapour in equilibrium with the condensed phase. 7. Boiling is the condition of free vaporization throughout the liquid. 8. The boiling temperature is the temperature at which the vapour pressure of a liquid is equal to the external pressure. 9. The critical temperature is the temperature at which a liquid surface disappears and above which a liquid does not exist whatever the pressure. The critical pressure is the vapour pressure at the critical temperature. 10. A supercritical fluid is a dense fluid phase above the critical temperature. 11. The melting temperature (or freezing temperature) is the temperature at which, under a specified pressure, the liquid and solid phases of a substance coexist in equilibrium. 12. The triple point is a point on a phase diagram at which the three phase boundaries meet and all three phases are in mutual equilibrium. 13. The chemical potential µ of a pure substance is the molar Gibbs energy of the substance. 132 4 PHYSICAL TRANSFORMATIONS OF PURE SUBSTANCES Discussion questions 4.1 Discuss the implications for phase stability of the variation of chemical potential with temperature and pressure. 4.2 Suggest a physical interpretation of the phenomena of superheating and supercooling. 4.3 Discuss what would be observed as a sample of water is taken along a path that encircles and is close to its critical point. 4.4 Use the phase diagram in Fig. 4.4 to state what would be observed when a sample of carbon dioxide, initially at 1.0 atm and 298 K, is subjected to the following cycle: (a) isobaric (constant–pressure) heating to 320 K, (b) isothermal compression to 100 atm, (c) isobaric cooling to 210 K, (d) isothermal decompression to 1.0 atm, (e) isobaric heating to 298 K. 4.5 The use of supercritical fluids for the extraction of a component from a complicated mixture is not confined to the decaffeination of coffee. Consult library and internet resources and prepare a discussion of the principles, advantages, disadvantages, and current uses of supercritical fluid extraction technology. 4.6 Explain the significance of the Clapeyron equation and of the Clausius–Clapeyron equation. 4.7 Distinguish between a first-order phase transition, a second-order phase transition, and a λ-transition at both molecular and macroscopic levels. Exercises 4.1(a) The vapour pressure of dichloromethane at 24.1°C is 53.3 kPa and its enthalpy of vaporization is 28.7 kJ mol−1 . Estimate the temperature at which its vapour pressure is 70.0 kPa. 4.1(b) The vapour pressure of a substance at 20.0°C is 58.0 kPa and its enthalpy of vaporization is 32.7 kJ mol−1 . Estimate the temperature at which its vapour pressure is 66.0 kPa. 4.2(a) The molar volume of a certain solid is 161.0 cm3 mol−1 at 1.00 atm and 350.75 K, its melting temperature. The molar volume of the liquid at this temperature and pressure is 163.3 cm3 mol−1 . At 100 atm the melting temperature changes to 351.26 K. Calculate the enthalpy and entropy of fusion of the solid. 4.2(b) The molar volume of a certain solid is 142.0 cm3 mol−1 at 1.00 atm and 427.15 K, its melting temperature. The molar volume of the liquid at this temperature and pressure is 152.6 cm3 mol−1 . At 1.2 MPa the melting temperature changes to 429.26 K. Calculate the enthalpy and entropy of fusion of the solid. 4.3(a) The vapour pressure of a liquid in the temperature range 200 K to 260 K was found to fit the expression ln(p/Torr) = 16.255 – 2501.8/(T/K). Calculate the enthalpy of vaporization of the liquid. 4.3(b) The vapour pressure of a liquid in the temperature range 200 K to 260 K was found to fit the expression ln(p/Torr) = 18.361 – 3036.8/(T/K). Calculate the enthalpy of vaporization of the liquid. Further reading Articles and texts E.K.H. Salje, Phase transitions, structural. In Encyclopedia of applied physics (ed. G.L. Trigg), 13, 373. VCH, New York (1995). J.M. Sanchez, Order–disorder transitions. In Encyclopedia of applied physics (ed. G.L. Trigg), 13, 1. VCH, New York (1995). K.M. Scholsky, Supercritical phase transitions at very high pressure. J. Chem. Educ. 66, 989 (1989). W.D. Callister, Jr., Materials science and engineering, an introduction. Wiley, New York (2000). Sources of data and information3 T. Boublik, V. Fried, and E. Hála, The vapor pressures of pure substances. Elsevier, Amsterdam (1984). R.C. Weast (ed.), Handbook of chemistry and physics, Vol. 81. CRC Press, Boca Raton (2004). 14. The chemical potential is uniform throughout a system at equilibrium. 15. The chemical potential varies with temperature as (∂µ/∂T)p = −Sm and with pressure as (∂µ/∂p)T = Vm. 16. The vapour pressure in the presence of applied pressure is given by p = p*eVm∆P/RT . 17. The temperature dependence of the vapour pressure is given by the Clapeyron equation, dp/dT = ∆trsS/∆trsV. 18. The temperature dependence of the vapour pressure of a condensed phase is given by the Clausius–Clapeyron equation, d ln p/dT = ∆vapH/RT2 . 19. The Ehrenfest classification is a classification of phase transitions based on the behaviour of the chemical potential. 3 See Further reading in Chapter 2 for additional sources of thermochemical data. PROBLEMS 133 Problems* Numerical problems 4.1 The temperature dependence of the vapour pressure of solid sulfur dioxide can be approximately represented by the relation log(p/Torr) = 10.5916 − 1871.2/(T/K) and that of liquid sulfur dioxide by log(p/Torr) = 8.3186 − 1425.7/(T/K). Estimate the temperature and pressure of the triple point of sulfur dioxide. 4.2 Prior to the discovery that freon-12 (CF2Cl2) was harmful to the Earth’s ozone layer, it was frequently used as the dispersing agent in spray cans for hair spray, etc. Its enthalpy of vaporization at its normal boiling point of −29.2°C is 20.25 kJ mol−1 . Estimate the pressure that a can of hair spray using freon-12 had to withstand at 40°C, the temperature of a can that has been standing in sunlight. Assume that ∆vapH is a constant over the temperature range involved and equal to its value at −29.2°C. 4.3 The enthalpy of vaporization of a certain liquid is found to be 14.4 kJ mol−1 at 180 K, its normal boiling point. The molar volumes of the liquid and the vapour at the boiling point are 115 cm3 mol−1 and 14.5 dm3 mol−1 , respectively. (a) Estimate dp/dT from the Clapeyron equation and (b) the percentage error in its value if the Clausius–Clapeyron equation is used instead. 4.4 Calculate the difference in slope of the chemical potential against temperature on either side of (a) the normal freezing point of water and (b) the normal boiling point of water. (c) By how much does the chemical potential of water supercooled to −5.0°C exceed that of ice at that temperature? 4.5 Calculate the difference in slope of the chemical potential against pressure on either side of (a) the normal freezing point of water and (b) the normal boiling point of water. The densities of ice and water at 0°C are 0.917 g cm−3 and 1.000 g cm−3 , and those of water and water vapour at 100°C are 0.958 g cm−3 and 0.598 g dm−3 , respectively. By how much does the chemical potential of water vapour exceed that of liquid water at 1.2 atm and 100°C? 4.6 The enthalpy of fusion of mercury is 2.292 kJ mol−1 , and its normal freezing point is 234.3 K with a change in molar volume of +0.517 cm−3 mol−1 on melting. At what temperature will the bottom of a column of mercury (density 13.6 g cm−3 ) of height 10.0 m be expected to freeze? 4.7 50.0 dm3 of dry air was slowly bubbled through a thermally insulated beaker containing 250 g of water initially at 25°C. Calculate the final temperature. (The vapour pressure of water is approximately constant at 3.17 kPa throughout, and its heat capacity is 75.5 J K−1 mol−1 . Assume that the air is not heated or cooled and that water vapour is a perfect gas.) 4.8 The vapour pressure, p, of nitric acid varies with temperature as follows: θ/°C 0 20 40 50 70 80 90 100 p/kPa 1.92 6.38 17.7 27.7 62.3 89.3 124.9 170.9 What are (a) the normal boiling point and (b) the enthalpy of vaporization of nitric acid? 4.9 The vapour pressure of the ketone carvone (M = 150.2 g mol−1 ), a component of oil of spearmint, is as follows: θ/°C 57.4 100.4 133.0 157.3 203.5 227.5 p/Torr 1.00 10.0 40.0 100 400 760 What are (a) the normal boiling point and (b) the enthalpy of vaporization of carvone? * Problems denoted by the symbol ‡ were supplied by Charles Trapp, Carmen Giunta, and Marshall Cady. 4.4(a) The vapour pressure of benzene between 10°C and 30°C fits the expression log(p/Torr) = 7.960 – 1780/(T/K). Calculate (a) the enthalpy of vaporization and (b) the normal boiling point of benzene. 4.4(b) The vapour pressure of a liquid between 15°C and 35°C fits the expression log(p/Torr) = 8.750 − 1625/(T/K). Calculate (a) the enthalpy of vaporization and (b) the normal boiling point of the liquid. 4.5(a) When benzene freezes at 5.5°C its density changes from 0.879 g cm−3 to 0.891 g cm−3 . Its enthalpy of fusion is 10.59 kJ mol−1 . Estimate the freezing point of benzene at 1000 atm. 4.5(b) When a certain liquid freezes at −3.65°C its density changes from 0.789 g cm−3 to 0.801 g cm−3 . Its enthalpy of fusion is 8.68 kJ mol−1 . Estimate the freezing point of the liquid at 100 MPa. 4.6(a) In July in Los Angeles, the incident sunlight at ground level has a power density of 1.2 kW m−2 at noon. A swimming pool of area 50 m2 is directly exposed to the sun. What is the maximum rate of loss of water? Assume that all the radiant energy is absorbed. 4.6(b) Suppose the incident sunlight at ground level has a power density of 0.87 kW m−2 at noon. What is the maximum rate of loss of water from a lake of area 1.0 ha? (1 ha = 104 m2 .) Assume that all the radiant energy is absorbed. 4.7(a) An open vessel containing (a) water, (b) benzene, (c) mercury stands in a laboratory measuring 5.0 m × 5.0 m × 3.0 m at 25°C. What mass of each substance will be found in the air if there is no ventilation? (The vapour pressures are (a) 3.2 kPa, (b) 13.1 kPa, (c) 0.23 Pa.) 4.7(b) On a cold, dry morning after a frost, the temperature was −5°C and the partial pressure of water in the atmosphere fell to 0.30 kPa. Will the frost sublime? What partial pressure of water would ensure that the frost remained? 4.8(a) Naphthalene, C10H8, melts at 80.2°C. If the vapour pressure of the liquid is 1.3 kPa at 85.8°C and 5.3 kPa at 119.3°C, use the Clausius–Clapeyron equation to calculate (a) the enthalpy of vaporization, (b) the normal boiling point, and (c) the enthalpy of vaporization at the boiling point. 4.8(b) The normal boiling point of hexane is 69.0°C. Estimate (a) its enthalpy of vaporization and (b) its vapour pressure at 25°C and 60°C. 4.9(a) Calculate the melting point of ice under a pressure of 50 bar. Assume that the density of ice under these conditions is approximately 0.92 g cm−3 and that of liquid water is 1.00 g cm−3 . 4.9(b) Calculate the melting point of ice under a pressure of 10 MPa. Assume that the density of ice under these conditions is approximately 0.915 g cm−3 and that of liquid water is 0.998 g cm−3 . 4.10(a) What fraction of the enthalpy of vaporization of water is spent on expanding the water vapour? 4.10(b) What fraction of the enthalpy of vaporization of ethanol is spent on expanding its vapour? 134 4 PHYSICAL TRANSFORMATIONS OF PURE SUBSTANCES 4.10 Construct the phase diagram for benzene near its triple point at 36 Torr and 5.50°C using the following data: ∆fusH = 10.6 kJ mol−1 , ∆vapH = 30.8 kJ mol−1 , ρ(s) = 0.891 g cm−3 , ρ(l) = 0.879 g cm−3 . 4.11‡ In an investigation of thermophysical properties of toluene (R.D. Goodwin J. Phys. Chem. Ref. Data 18, 1565 (1989)) presented expressions for two coexistence curves (phase boundaries). The solid–liquid coexistence curve is given by p/bar = p3/bar + 1000 × (5.60 + 11.727x)x where x = T/T3 − 1 and the triple point pressure and temperature are p3 = 0.4362 µbar and T3 = 178.15 K. The liquid–vapour curve is given by: ln(p/bar) = −10.418/y + 21.157 − 15.996y + 14.015y2 − 5.0120y3 + 4.7224(1 − y)1.70 where y = T/Tc = T/(593.95 K). (a) Plot the solid–liquid and liquid–vapour phase boundaries. (b) Estimate the standard melting point of toluene. (c) Estimate the standard boiling point of toluene. (d) Compute the standard enthalpy of vaporization of toluene, given that the molar volumes of the liquid and vapour at the normal boiling point are 0.12 dm3 mol−1 and 30.3 dm3 mol−1 , respectively. 4.12‡ In a study of the vapour pressure of chloromethane, A. Bah and N. Dupont-Pavlovsky (J. Chem. Eng. Data 40, 869 (1995)) presented data for the vapour pressure over solid chloromethane at low temperatures. Some of that data is shown below: T/K 145.94 147.96 149.93 151.94 153.97 154.94 p/Pa 13.07 18.49 25.99 36.76 50.86 59.56 Estimate the standard enthalpy of sublimation of chloromethane at 150 K. (Take the molar volume of the vapour to be that of a perfect gas, and that of the solid to be negligible.) Theoretical problems 4.13 Show that, for a transition between two incompressible solid phases, ∆G is independent of the pressure. 4.14 The change in enthalpy is given by dH = CpdT + Vdp. The Clapeyron equation relates dp and dT at equilibrium, and so in combination the two equations can be used to find how the enthalpy changes along a phase boundary as the temperature changes and the two phases remain in equilibrium. Show that d(∆H/T) = ∆Cp d ln T. 4.15 In the ‘gas saturation method’ for the measurement of vapour pressure, a volume V of gas (as measured at a temperature T and a pressure p) is bubbled slowly through the liquid that is maintained at the temperature T, and a mass loss m is measured. Show that the vapour pressure, p, of the liquid is related to its molar mass, M, by p = AmP/(1 + Am), where A = RT/MPV. The vapour pressure of geraniol (M = 154.2 g mol−1 ), which is a component of oil of roses, was measured at 110°C. It was found that, when 5.00 dm3 of nitrogen at 760 Torr was passed slowly through the heated liquid, the loss of mass was 0.32 g. Calculate the vapour pressure of geraniol. 4.16 Combine the barometric formula (stated in Impact I1.1) for the dependence of the pressure on altitude with the Clausius–Clapeyron equation, and predict how the boiling temperature of a liquid depends on the altitude and the ambient temperature. Take the mean ambient temperature as 20°C and predict the boiling temperature of water at 3000 m. 4.17 Figure 4.9 gives a schematic representation of how the chemical potentials of the solid, liquid, and gaseous phases of a substance vary with temperature. All have a negative slope, but it is unlikely that they are truly straight lines as indicated in the illustration. Derive an expression for the curvatures (specifically, the second derivatives with respect to temperature) of these lines. Is there a restriction on the curvature of these lines? Which state of matter shows the greatest curvature? 4.18 The Clapeyron equation does not apply to second-order phase transitions, but there are two analogous equations, the Ehrenfest equations, that do. They are: = = where α is the expansion coefficient, κT the isothermal compressibility, and the subscripts 1 and 2 refer to two different phases. Derive these two equations. Why does the Clapeyron equation not apply to second-order transitions? 4.19 For a first-order phase transition, to which the Clapeyron equation does apply, prove the relation CS = Cp − where CS = (∂q/∂T)S is the heat capacity along the coexistence curve of two phases. Applications: to biology and engineering 4.20 Proteins are polypeptides, polymers of amino acids that can exist in ordered structures stabilized by a variety of molecular interactions. However, when certain conditions are changed, the compact structure of a polypeptide chain may collapse into a random coil. This structural change may be regarded as a phase transition occurring at a characteristic transition temperature, the melting temperature, Tm, which increases with the strength and number of intermolecular interactions in the chain. A thermodynamic treatment allows predictions to be made of the temperature Tm for the unfolding of a helical polypeptide held together by hydrogen bonds into a random coil. If a polypeptide has n amino acids, n − 4 hydrogen bonds are formed to form an α-helix, the most common type of helix in naturally occurring proteins (see Chapter 19). Because the first and last residues in the chain are free to move, n − 2 residues form the compact helix and have restricted motion. Based on these ideas, the molar Gibbs energy of unfolding of a polypeptide with n ≥ 5 may be written as ∆Gm = (n − 4)∆hbHm − (n − 2)T∆hbSm where ∆hbHm and ∆hbSm are, respectively, the molar enthalpy and entropy of dissociation of hydrogen bonds in the polypeptide. (a) Justify the form of the equation for the Gibbs energy of unfolding. That is, why are the enthalpy and entropy terms written as (n − 4)∆hbHm and (n − 2)∆hbSm, respectively? (b) Show that Tm may be written as Tm = (c) Plot Tm/(∆hbHm/∆hbSm) for 5 ≤ n ≤ 20. At what value of n does Tm change by less than 1% when n increases by one? 4.21‡ The use of supercritical fluids as mobile phases in SFC depends on their properties as nonpolar solvents. The solubility parameter, δ, is defined as (∆Ucohesive/Vm)1/2 , where ∆Ucohesive is the cohesive energy of the solvent, the energy per mole needed to increase the volume isothermally to an infinite value. Diethyl ether, carbon tetrachloride, and dioxane have solubility parameter ranges of 7–8, 8–9, and 10–11, respectively. (a) Derive a practical equation for the computation of the isotherms for the reduced internal energy change, ∆Ur(Tr,Vr) defined as ∆Ur(Tr,Vr) = (b) Draw a graph of ∆Ur against pr for the isotherms Tr = 1,1.2, and 1.5 in the reduced pressure range for which 0.7 ≤ Vr ≤ 2. (c) Draw a graph of δ against pr for the carbon dioxide isotherms Tr = 1 and 1.5 in the reduced pressure range for which 1 ≤ Vr ≤ 3. In what pressure range at Tf = 1 will carbon dioxide have Ur(Tr,Vr) − Ur(Tr,∞) pcVc (n − 4)∆hbHm (n − 2)∆hbSm αV∆trsH ∆trsV Cp,m2 − Cp,m1 TVm(α2 − α1) dp dT α2 − α1 κT,2 − κT,1 dp dT PROBLEMS 135 solvent properties similar to those of liquid carbon tetrachloride? Hint. Use mathematical software or a spreadsheet. 4.22‡ A substance as well–known as methane still receives research attention because it is an important component of natural gas, a commonly used fossil fuel . Friend et al. have published a review of thermophysical properties of methane (D.G. Friend, J.F. Ely, and H. Ingham, J. Phys. Chem. Ref. Data 18, 583 (1989)), which included the following data describing the liquid–vapour phase boundary. T/K 100 108 110 112 114 120 130 140 150 160 170 190 p/MPa 0.034 0.074 0.088 0.104 0.122 0.192 0.368 0.642 1.041 1.593 2.329 4.521 (a) Plot the liquid–vapour phase boundary. (b) Estimate the standard boiling point of methane. (c) Compute the standard enthalpy of vaporization of methane, given that the molar volumes of the liquid and vapour at the standard boiling point are 3.80 × 10−2 and 8.89 dm3 mol−1 , respectively. 4.23‡ Diamond, an allotrope of carbon, is the hardest substance and the best conductor of heat yet characterized. For these reasons, diamond is used widely in industrial applications that require a strong abrasive. Unfortunately, it is difficult to synthesize diamond from the more readily available allotropes of carbon, such as graphite. To illustrate this point, calculate the pressure required to convert graphite into diamond at 25°C. The following data apply to 25°C and 100 kPa. Assume the specific volume, Vs, and κT are constant with respect to pressure changes. Graphite Diamond ∆fG7 /(kJ mol−1 ) 0 +2.8678 Vs/(cm3 g−1 ) 0.444 0.284 κT/kPa 3.04 × 10−8 0.187 × 10−8 Simple mixtures This chapter begins by developing the concept of chemical potential to show that it is a particular case of a class of properties called partial molar quantities. Then it explores how to use the chemical potential of a substance to describe the physical properties of mixtures. The underlying principle to keep in mind is that at equilibrium the chemical potential of a species is the same in every phase. We see, by making use of the experimental observations known as Raoult’s and Henry’s laws, how to express the chemical potential of a substance in terms of its mole fraction in a mixture. With this result established, we can calculate the effect of a solute on certain thermodynamic properties of a solution. These properties include the lowering of vapour pressure of the solvent, the elevation of its boiling point, the depression of its freezing point, and the origin of osmotic pressure. Finally, we see how to express the chemical potential of a substance in a real mixture in terms of a property known as the activity. We see how the activity may be measured, and conclude with a discussion of how the standard states of solutes and solvents are defined and how ion–ion interactions are taken into account in electrolyte solutions. Chemistry deals with mixtures, including mixtures of substances that can react together. Therefore, we need to generalize the concepts introduced so far to deal with substances that are mingled together. As a first step towards dealing with chemical reactions (which are treated in Chapter 7), here we consider mixtures of substances that do not react together. At this stage we deal mainly with binary mixtures, which are mixtures of two components, A and B. We shall therefore often be able to simplify equations by making use of the relation xA + xB = 1. The thermodynamic description of mixtures We have already seen that the partial pressure, which is the contribution of one component to the total pressure, is used to discuss the properties of mixtures of gases. For a more general description of the thermodynamics of mixtures we need to introduce other analogous ‘partial’ properties. 5.1 Partial molar quantities The easiest partial molar property to visualize is the ‘partial molar volume’, the contribution that a component of a mixture makes to the total volume of a sample. (a) Partial molar volume Imagine a huge volume of pure water at 25°C. When a further 1 mol H2O is added, the volume increases by 18 cm3 and we can report that 18 cm3 mol−1 is the molar volume The thermodynamic description of mixtures 5.1 Partial molar quantities 5.2 The thermodynamics of mixing 5.3 The chemical potentials of liquids I5.1 Impact on biology: Gas solubility and breathing The properties of solutions 5.4 Liquid mixtures 5.5 Colligative properties I5.2 Impact on biology: Osmosis in physiology and biochemistry Activities 5.6 The solvent activity 5.7 The solute activity 5.8 The activities of regular solutions 5.9 The activities of ions in solution Checklist of key ideas Further reading Further information 5.1: The Debye–Hückel theory of ionic solutions Discussion questions Exercises Problems 5 5.1 PARTIAL MOLAR QUANTITIES 137 of pure water. However, when we add 1 mol H2O to a huge volume of pure ethanol, the volume increases by only 14 cm3 . The reason for the different increase in volume is that the volume occupied by a given number of water molecules depends on the identity of the molecules that surround them. In the latter case there is so much ethanol present that each H2O molecule is surrounded by ethanol molecules, and the packing of the molecules results in the H2O molecules increasing the volume by only 14 cm3 . The quantity 14 cm3 mol−1 is the partial molar volume of water in pure ethanol. In general, the partial molar volume of a substance A in a mixture is the change in volume per mole of A added to a large volume of the mixture. The partial molar volumes of the components of a mixture vary with composition because the environment of each type of molecule changes as the composition changes from pure A to pure B. It is this changing molecular environment, and the consequential modification of the forces acting between molecules, that results in the variation of the thermodynamic properties of a mixture as its composition is changed. The partial molar volumes of water and ethanol across the full composition range at 25°C are shown in Fig. 5.1. The partial molar volume, VJ , of a substance J at some general composition is defined formally as follows: VJ = p,T,n′ [5.1] where the subscript n′ signifies that the amounts of all other substances present are constant.1 The partial molar volume is the slope of the plot of the total volume as the amount of J is changed, the pressure, temperature, and amount of the other components being constant (Fig. 5.2). Its value depends on the composition, as we saw for water and ethanol. The definition in eqn 5.1 implies that, when the composition of the mixture is changed by the addition of dnA of A and dnB of B, then the total volume of the mixture changes by dV = p,T,nB dnA + p,T,nA dnB = VAdnA + VBdnB (5.2) Provided the composition is held constant as the amounts of A and B are increased, the final volume of a mixture can be calculated by integration. Because the partial molar volumes are constant (provided the composition is held constant throughout the integration) we can write V = Ύ nA 0 VAdnA + Ύ nB 0 VBdnB = VAΎ nA 0 dnA + VBΎ nB 0 dnB = VAnA + VBnB (5.3) Although we have envisaged the two integrations as being linked (in order to preserve constant composition), because V is a state function the final result in eqn 5.3 is valid however the solution is in fact prepared. Partial molar volumes can be measured in several ways. One method is to measure the dependence of the volume on the composition and to fit the observed volume to a function of the amount of the substance. Once the function has been found, its slope can be determined at any composition of interest by differentiation. D F ∂V ∂nB A C D F ∂V ∂nA A C D F ∂V ∂nJ A C Water Ethanol 18 16 14 58 56 54 0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1 Partialmolarvolumeofwater,(HO)/(cmmol)V2 3–1 Partialmolarvolumeofethanol,(CHOH)/(cmmol)V25 3–1 Mole fraction of ethanol, (C H OH)x 2 5 Fig. 5.1 The partial molar volumes of water and ethanol at 25°C. Note the different scales (water on the left, ethanol on the right). Volume,V Amount of A, nA a b V( ) V( ) 0 a b Fig. 5.2 The partial molar volume of a substance is the slope of the variation of the total volume of the sample plotted against the composition. In general, partial molar quantities vary with the composition, as shown by the different slopes at the compositions a and b. Note that the partial molar volume at b is negative: the overall volume of the sample decreases as A is added. 1 The IUPAC recommendation is to denote a partial molar quantity by }, but only when there is the possibility of confusion with the quantity X. For instance, the partial molar volume of NaCl in water could be written {(NaCl, aq) to distinguish it from the volume of the solution, V(NaCl, aq). 138 5 SIMPLE MIXTURES 0 5 10 x Partialmolarvolume,/(cmmol)VE 31 53 54 55 56 Fig. 5.3 The partial molar volume of ethanol as expressed by the polynomial in Illustration 5.1. Exploration Using the data from Illustration 5.1, determine the value of b at which VE has a minimum value. Amount of A, nA a b 0 Gibbsenergy,G ( )a ( )b m m Fig. 5.4 The chemical potential of a substance is the slope of the total Gibbs energy of a mixture with respect to the amount of substance of interest. In general, the chemical potential varies with composition, as shown for the two values at a and b. In this case, both chemical potentials are positive. Illustration 5.1 The determination of partial molar volume A polynomial fit to measurements of the total volume of a water/ethanol mixture at 25°C that contains 1.000 kg of water is v = 1002.93 + 54.6664x − 0.363 94x2 + 0.028 256x3 where v = V/cm3 , x = nE/mol, and nE is the amount of CH3CH2OH present. The partial molar volume of ethanol, VE, is therefore VE = p,T,nW = p,T,nW cm3 mol−1 = p,T,nW cm3 mol−1 Then, because = 54.6664 − 2(0.36394)x + 3(0.028256)x2 we can conclude that VE/(cm3 mol−1 ) = 54.6664 − 0.72788x + 0.084768x2 Figure 5.3 is a graph of this function. Self-test 5.1 At 25°C, the density of a 50 per cent by mass ethanol/water solution is 0.914 g cm−3 . Given that the partial molar volume of water in the solution is 17.4 cm3 mol−1 , what is the partial molar volume of the ethanol? [56.4 cm3 mol−1 ] Molar volumes are always positive, but partial molar quantities need not be. For example, the limiting partial molar volume of MgSO4 in water (its partial molar volume in the limit of zero concentration) is −1.4 cm3 mol−1 , which means that the addition of 1 mol MgSO4 to a large volume of water results in a decrease in volume of 1.4 cm3 . The mixture contracts because the salt breaks up the open structure of water as the ions become hydrated, and it collapses slightly. (b) Partial molar Gibbs energies The concept of a partial molar quantity can be extended to any extensive state function. For a substance in a mixture, the chemical potential is defined as the partial molar Gibbs energy: µJ = p,T,n′ [5.4] That is, the chemical potential is the slope of a plot of Gibbs energy against the amount of the component J, with the pressure and temperature (and the amounts of the other substances) held constant (Fig. 5.4). For a pure substance we can write G = nJGJ,m, and from eqn 5.4 obtain µJ = GJ,m: in this case, the chemical potential is simply the molar Gibbs energy of the substance, as we used in Chapter 4. By the same argument that led to eqn 5.3, it follows that the total Gibbs energy of a binary mixture is G = nAµA + nBµB (5.5) where µA and µB are the chemical potentials at the composition of the mixture. That is, the chemical potential of a substance in a mixture is the contribution of that D F ∂G ∂nJ A C dv dx D F ∂v ∂x A C D F ∂(V/cm3 ) ∂(nE/mol) A C D F ∂V ∂nE A C 5.1 PARTIAL MOLAR QUANTITIES 139 substance to the total Gibbs energy of the mixture. Because the chemical potentials depend on composition (and the pressure and temperature), the Gibbs energy of a mixture may change when these variables change, and for a system of components A, B, etc., the equation dG = Vdp − SdT becomes dG = Vdp − SdT + µAdnA + µBdnB + · · · (5.6) This expression is the fundamentalequationofchemicalthermodynamics. Its implications and consequences are explored and developed in this and the next two chapters. At constant pressure and temperature, eqn 5.6 simplifies to dG = µAdnA + µBdnB + · · · (5.7) We saw in Section 3.5e that under the same conditions dG = dwadd,max. Therefore, at constant temperature and pressure, dwadd,max = µAdnA + µBdnB + · · · (5.8) That is, additional (non-expansion) work can arise from the changing composition of a system. For instance, in an electrochemical cell, the chemical reaction is arranged to take place in two distinct sites (at the two electrodes). The electrical work the cell performs can be traced to its changing composition as products are formed from reactants. (c) The wider significance of the chemical potential The chemical potential does more than show how G varies with composition. Because G = U + pV − TS, and therefore U = −pV + TS + G, we can write a general infinitesimal change in U for a system of variable composition as dU = −pdV − Vdp + SdT + TdS + dG = −pdV − Vdp + SdT + TdS + (Vdp − SdT + µAdnA + µBdnB + · · · ) = −pdV + TdS + µAdnA + µBdnB + · · · This expression is the generalization of eqn 3.43 (that dU = TdS − pdV) to systems in which the composition may change. It follows that at constant volume and entropy, dU = µAdnA + µBdnB + · · · (5.9) and hence that µJ = S,V,n′ (5.10) Therefore, not only does the chemical potential show how G changes when the composition changes, it also shows how the internal energy changes too (but under a different set of conditions). In the same way it is easy to deduce that (a) µJ = S,p,n′ (b) µJ = V,T,n′ (5.11) Thus we see that the µJ shows how all the extensive thermodynamic properties U, H, A, and G depend on the composition. This is why the chemical potential is so central to chemistry. (d) The Gibbs–Duhem equation Because the total Gibbs energy of a binary mixture is given by eqn 5.5 and the chemical potentials depend on the composition, when the compositions are changed infinitesimally we might expect G of a binary system to change by dG = µAdnA + µBdnB + nAdµA + nBdµB D F ∂A ∂nJ A C D F ∂H ∂nJ A C D F ∂U ∂nJ A C 140 5 SIMPLE MIXTURES Comment 5.1 The molar concentration (colloquially, the ‘molarity’, [J] or cJ) is the amount of solute divided by the volume of the solution and is usually expressed in moles per cubic decimetre (mol dm−3 ). We write c7 = 1 mol dm−3 . The term molality, b, is the amount of solute divided by the mass of solvent and is usually expressed in moles per kilogram of solvent (mol kg−1 ). We write b7 = 1 mol kg−1 . However, we have seen that at constant pressure and temperature a change in Gibbs energy is given by eqn 5.7. Because G is a state function, these two equations must be equal, which implies that at constant temperature and pressure nAdµA + nBdµB = 0 (5.12a) This equation is a special case of the Gibbs–Duhem equation: ∑ J nJdµJ = 0 (5.12b) The significance of the Gibbs–Duhem equation is that the chemical potential of one component of a mixture cannot change independently of the chemical potentials of the other components. In a binary mixture, if one partial molar quantity increases, then the other must decrease, with the two changes related by dµB = − dµA (5.13) The same line of reasoning applies to all partial molar quantities. We can see in Fig. 5.1, for example, that, where the partial molar volume of water increases, that of ethanol decreases. Moreover, as eqn 5.13 shows, and as we can see from Fig. 5.1, a small change in the partial molar volume of A corresponds to a large change in the partial molar volume of B if nA/nB is large, but the opposite is true when this ratio is small. In practice, the Gibbs–Duhem equation is used to determine the partial molar volume of one component of a binary mixture from measurements of the partial molar volume of the second component. Example 5.1 Using the Gibbs–Duhem equation The experimental values of the partial molar volume of K2SO4(aq) at 298 K are found to fit the expression vB = 32.280 + 18.216x1/2 where vB = VK2SO4 /(cm3 mol−1 ) and x is the numerical value of the molality of K2SO4 (x = b/b7 ; see Comment 5.1). Use the Gibbs–Duhem equation to derive an equation for the molar volume of water in the solution. The molar volume of pure water at 298 K is 18.079 cm3 mol−1 . Method Let A denote H2O, the solvent, and B denote K2SO4, the solute. The Gibbs–Duhem equation for the partial molar volumes of two components is nAdVA + nBdVB = 0. This relation implies that dvA = −(nB/nA)dvB, and therefore that vA can be found by integration: vA = vA* − Ύ dvB where vA* = VA/(cm3 mol−1 ) is the numerical value of the molar volume of pure A. The first step is to change the variable vB to x = b/b7 and then to integrate the righthand side between x = 0 (pure B) and the molality of interest. Answer It follows from the information in the question that, with B = K2SO4, dvB/dx = 9.108x−1/2 . Therefore, the integration required is vB = vB* − 9.108Ύ0 b/b7 x−1/2 dx nB nA nB nA nA nB 5.2 THE THERMODYNAMICS OF MIXING 141 32 34 36 38 40 V(KSO)/(cmmol)24 3–1 V(HO)/(cmmol)2 3–1 18.075 18.076 18.078 18.079 0 0.05 0.1 b/(mol kg )–1 Fig. 5.5 The partial molar volumes of the components of an aqueous solution of potassium sulfate. n T pA, , n T pB, , T p p p p p, , withA B A B+ = Fig. 5.6 The arrangement for calculating the thermodynamic functions of mixing of two perfect gases. However, the ratio of amounts of A (H2O) and B (K2SO4) is related to the molality of B, b = nB/(1 kg water) and nA = (1 kg water)/MA where MA is the molar mass of water, by = = = bMA = xb7 MA and hence vA = vA* − 9.108MAb7 Ύ0 b/b7 x1/2 dx = vA* − 2 –3{9.108MAb7 (b/b7 )3/2 } It then follows, by substituting the data (including MA = 1.802 × 10−2 kg mol−1 , the molar mass of water), that VA/(cm3 mol−1 ) = 18.079 − 0.1094(b/b7 )3/2 The partial molar volumes are plotted in Fig. 5.5. Self-test 5.2 Repeat the calculation for a salt B for which VB/(cm3 mol−1 ) = 6.218 + 5.146b − 7.147b2 . [VA/(cm3 mol−1 ) = 18.079 − 0.0464b2 + 0.0859b3 ] 5.2 The thermodynamics of mixing The dependence of the Gibbs energy of a mixture on its composition is given by eqn 5.5, and we know that at constant temperature and pressure systems tend towards lower Gibbs energy. This is the link we need in order to apply thermodynamics to the discussion of spontaneous changes of composition, as in the mixing of two substances. One simple example of a spontaneous mixing process is that of two gases introduced into the same container. The mixing is spontaneous, so it must correspond to a decrease in G. We shall now see how to express this idea quantitatively. (a) The Gibbs energy of mixing of perfect gases Let the amounts of two perfect gases in the two containers be nA and nB; both are at a temperature T and a pressure p (Fig. 5.6). At this stage, the chemical potentials of the two gases have their ‘pure’ values, which are obtained by applying the definition µ = Gm to eqn 3.57: µ = µ7 + RT ln (5.14a)° where µ7 is the standard chemical potential, the chemical potential of the pure gas at 1 bar. It will be much simpler notationally if we agree to let p denote the pressure relative to p7 ; that is, to replace p/p7 by p, for then we can write µ = µ7 + RT ln p {5.14b}° Equations for which this convention is used will be labelled {1}, {2}, . . . ; to use the equations, we have to remember to replace p by p/p7 again. In practice, that simply means using the numerical value of p in bars. The Gibbs energy of the total system is then given by eqn 5.5 as Gi = nAµA + nBµB = nA(µA 7 + RT ln p) + nB(µB 7 + RT ln p) {5.15}° p p7 nBMA 1 kg nB (1 kg)/MA nB nA 142 5 SIMPLE MIXTURES 3.0 mol H2 3.0 mol H2 1.0 mol N2 1.0 mol N2 3p p p p(H ) =2 p p(N ) =2 2p 1 0 -0.2 -0.4 -0.6 -0.8 0 0.5 1 Mole fraction of A, xA DmixGnRT/ Fig. 5.7 The Gibbs energy of mixing of two perfect gases and (as discussed later) of two liquids that form an ideal solution. The Gibbs energy of mixing is negative for all compositions and temperatures, so perfect gases mix spontaneously in all proportions. Exploration Draw graphs of ∆mixG against xA at different temperatures in the range 298 K to 500 K. For what value of xA does ∆mixG depend on temperature most strongly? Fig. 5.8 The initial and final states considered in the calculation of the Gibbs energy of mixing of gases at different initial pressures. After mixing, the partial pressures of the gases are pA and pB, with pA + pB = p. The total Gibbs energy changes to Gf = nA(µA 7 + RT ln pA) + nB(µB 7 + RT ln pB) {5.16}° The difference Gf − Gi, the Gibbs energy of mixing, ∆mixG, is therefore ∆mixG = nART ln + nBRT ln (5.17)° At this point we may replace nJ by xJn, where n is the total amount of A and B, and use the relation between partial pressure and mole fraction (Section 1.2b) to write pJ/p = xJ for each component, which gives ∆mixG = nRT(xA ln xA + xB ln xB) (5.18)° Because mole fractions are never greater than 1, the logarithms in this equation are negative, and ∆mixG < 0 (Fig. 5.7). The conclusion that ∆mixG is negative for all compositions confirms that perfect gases mix spontaneously in all proportions. However, theequationextendscommonsensebyallowingustodiscusstheprocessquantitatively. Example 5.2 Calculating a Gibbs energy of mixing A container is divided into two equal compartments (Fig. 5.8). One contains 3.0 mol H2(g) at 25°C; the other contains 1.0 mol N2(g) at 25°C. Calculate the Gibbs energy of mixing when the partition is removed. Assume perfect behaviour. Method Equation 5.18 cannot be used directly because the two gases are initially at different pressures. We proceed by calculating the initial Gibbs energy from the chemical potentials. To do so, we need the pressure of each gas. Write the pressure of nitrogen as p; then the pressure of hydrogen as a multiple of p can be found from the gas laws. Next, calculate the Gibbs energy for the system when the partition is removed. The volume occupied by each gas doubles, so its initial partial pressure is halved. Answer Given that the pressure of nitrogen is p, the pressure of hydrogen is 3p; therefore, the initial Gibbs energy is Gi = (3.0 mol){µ7 (H2) + RT ln 3p} + (1.0 mol){µ7 (N2) + RT ln p} When the partition is removed and each gas occupies twice the original volume, the partial pressure of nitrogen falls to 1 –2p and that of hydrogen falls to 3 –2 p. Therefore, the Gibbs energy changes to Gf = (3.0 mol){µ7 (H2) + RT ln 3 –2 p} + (1.0 mol){µ7 (N2) + RT ln 1 –2 p} The Gibbs energy of mixing is the difference of these two quantities: ∆mixG = (3.0 mol)RT ln + (1.0 mol)RT ln = −(3.0 mol)RT ln2 − (1.0 mol)RT ln2 = −(4.0 mol)RT ln2 = −6.9 kJ In this example, the value of ∆mixG is the sum of two contributions: the mixing itself, and the changes in pressure of the two gases to their final total pressure, 2p. When 3.0 mol H2 mixes with 1.0 mol N2 at the same pressure, with the volumes of the vessels adjusted accordingly, the change of Gibbs energy is −5.6 kJ. D F 1 –2 p p A C D F 3 –2 p 3p A C pB p pA p 5.3 THE CHEMICAL POTENTIALS OF LIQUIDS 143 0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 0 0.5 1 Mole fraction of A, xA DmixSnR/ Fig. 5.9 The entropy of mixing of two perfect gases and (as discussed later) of two liquids that form an ideal solution. The entropy increases for all compositions and temperatures, so perfect gases mix spontaneously in all proportions. Because there is no transfer of heat to the surroundings when perfect gases mix, the entropy of the surroundings is unchanged. Hence, the graph also shows the total entropy of the system plus the surroundings when perfect gases mix. A(g) + B(g) A(g, )p A(l) A(l) + B(l) Equal at equilibrium m m Fig. 5.10 At equilibrium, the chemical potential of the gaseous form of a substance A is equal to the chemical potential of its condensed phase. The equality is preserved if a solute is also present. Because the chemical potential of A in the vapour depends on its partial vapour pressure, it follows that the chemical potential of liquid A can be related to its partial vapour pressure. Self-test 5.3 Suppose that 2.0 mol H2 at 2.0 atm and 25°C and 4.0 mol N2 at 3.0 atm and 25°C are mixed at constant volume. Calculate ∆mixG. What would be the value of ∆mixG had the pressures been identical initially? [−9.7 kJ, −9.5 kJ] (b) Other thermodynamic mixing functions Because (∂G/∂T)p,n = −S, it follows immediately from eqn 5.18 that, for a mixture of perfect gases initially at the same pressure, the entropy of mixing, ∆mixS, is ∆mixS = p,nA,nB = −nR(xA lnxA + xB lnxB) (5.19)° Because ln x < 0, it follows that ∆mixS > 0 for all compositions (Fig. 5.9). For equal amounts of gas, for instance, we set xA = xB = 1 –2 , and obtain ∆mixS = nR ln 2, with n the total amount of gas molecules. This increase in entropy is what we expect when one gas disperses into the other and the disorder increases. We can calculate the isothermal, isobaric (constant pressure) enthalpy of mixing, ∆mixH, the enthalpy change accompanying mixing, of two perfect gases from ∆G = ∆H − T∆S. It follows from eqns 5.18 and 5.19 that ∆mixH = 0 (5.20)° The enthalpy of mixing is zero, as we should expect for a system in which there are no interactions between the molecules forming the gaseous mixture. It follows that the whole of the driving force for mixing comes from the increase in entropy of the system, because the entropy of the surroundings is unchanged. 5.3 The chemical potentials of liquids To discuss the equilibrium properties of liquid mixtures we need to know how the Gibbs energy of a liquid varies with composition. To calculate its value, we use the fact that, at equilibrium, the chemical potential of a substance present as a vapour must be equal to its chemical potential in the liquid. (a) Ideal solutions We shall denote quantities relating to pure substances by a superscript *, so the chemical potential of pure A is written µA*, and as µA*(l) when we need to emphasize that A is a liquid. Because the vapour pressure of the pure liquid is pA*, it follows from eqn 5.14 that the chemical potential of A in the vapour (treated as a perfect gas) is µA 7 + RT ln pA* (with pA to be interpreted as the relative pressure pA/p7 ). These two chemical potentials are equal at equilibrium (Fig. 5.10), so we can write µA* = µA 7 + RT ln pA* {5.21} If another substance, a solute, is also present in the liquid, the chemical potential of A in the liquid is changed to µA and its vapour pressure is changed to pA. The vapour and solvent are still in equilibrium, so we can write µA = µA 7 + RT ln pA {5.22} Next, we combine these two equations to eliminate the standard chemical potential of the gas. To do so, we write eqn 5.21 as µA 7 = µA* – RT ln pA* and substitute this expression into eqn 5.22 to obtain D F ∂∆mixG ∂T A C 144 5 SIMPLE MIXTURES 0 1Mole fraction of A, xA Partial pressure of A Partial pressure of B Total pressure pB* pA* Pressure Fig. 5.11 The total vapour pressure and the two partial vapour pressures of an ideal binary mixture are proportional to the mole fractions of the components. 60 40 20 0 Pressure,/Torrp 0 Mole fraction of methylbenzene, (C H CH )x 6 5 3 1 Benzene Methylbenzene Total 80 Fig. 5.12 Two similar liquids, in this case benzene and methylbenzene (toluene), behave almost ideally, and the variation of their vapour pressures with composition resembles that for an ideal solution. Blocked Fig. 5.13 A pictorial representation of the molecular basis of Raoult’s law. The large spheres represent solvent molecules at the surface of a solution (the uppermost line of spheres), and the small spheres are solute molecules. The latter hinder the escape of solvent molecules into the vapour, but do not hinder their return. µA = µA* − RT ln pA* + RT ln pA = µA* + RT ln (5.23) In the final step we draw on additional experimental information about the relation between the ratio of vapour pressures and the composition of the liquid. In a series of experiments on mixtures of closely related liquids (such as benzene and methylbenzene), the French chemist François Raoult found that the ratio of the partial vapour pressure of each component to its vapour pressure as a pure liquid, pA/pA*, is approximately equal to the mole fraction of A in the liquid mixture. That is, he established what we now call Raoult’s law: pA = xA pA* (5.24)° This law is illustrated in Fig. 5.11. Some mixtures obey Raoult’s law very well, especially when the components are structurally similar (Fig. 5.12). Mixtures that obey the law throughout the composition range from pure A to pure B are called ideal solutions. When we write equations that are valid only for ideal solutions, we shall label them with a superscript °, as in eqn 5.24. For an ideal solution, it follows from eqns 5.23 and 5.24 that µA = µA* + RT ln xA (5.25)° This important equation can be used as the definition of an ideal solution (so that it implies Raoult’s law rather than stemming from it). It is in fact a better definition than eqn 5.24 because it does not assume that the vapour is a perfect gas. Molecular interpretation 5.1 The molecular origin of Raoult’s law The origin of Raoult’s law can be understood in molecular terms by considering the rates at which molecules leave and return to the liquid. The law reflects the fact that the presence of a second component reduces the rate at which A molecules leave the surface of the liquid but does not inhibit the rate at which they return (Fig. 5.13). pA pA* 5.3 THE CHEMICAL POTENTIALS OF LIQUIDS 145 Ideal dilute solution (Henry) Real Ideal solution (Raoult) Mole fraction of B, xB 0 1 Pressure KB pB* Fig. 5.15 When a component (the solvent) is nearly pure, it has a vapour pressure that is proportional to mole fraction with a slope pB* (Raoult’s law). When it is the minor component (the solute) its vapour pressure is still proportional to the mole fraction, but the constant of proportionality is now KB (Henry’s law). 0 1Mole fraction of carbon disulfide, (CS )x 2 500 400 300 200 100 0 Total Carbon disulfide Acetone Pressure,/Torrp Fig. 5.14 Strong deviations from ideality are shown by dissimilar liquids (in this case carbon disulfide and acetone, propanone). The rate at which A molecules leave the surface is proportional to the number of them at the surface, which in turn is proportional to the mole fraction of A: rate of vaporization = kxA where k is a constant of proportionality. The rate at which molecules condense is proportional to their concentration in the gas phase, which in turn is proportional to their partial pressure: rate of condensation = k′pA At equilibrium, the rates of vaporization and condensation are equal, so k′pA = kxA. It follows that pA = xA For the pure liquid, xA = 1; so in this special case pA* = k/k′. Equation 5.24 then follows by substitution of this relation into the line above. Some solutions depart significantly from Raoult’s law (Fig. 5.14). Nevertheless, even in these cases the law is obeyed increasingly closely for the component in excess (the solvent) as it approaches purity. The law is therefore a good approximation for the properties of the solvent if the solution is dilute. (b) Ideal-dilute solutions In ideal solutions the solute, as well as the solvent, obeys Raoult’s law. However, the English chemist William Henry found experimentally that, for real solutions at low concentrations, although the vapour pressure of the solute is proportional to its mole fraction, the constant of proportionality is not the vapour pressure of the pure substance (Fig. 5.15). Henry’s law is: k k′ 146 5 SIMPLE MIXTURES 200 100 0 0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 p*(chloroform) K(CHCl )3 K(CH COCH )3 3 p*(acetone) Mole fraction of chloroform, (CHCl )x 3 Raoult's law Henry's law Pressure/Torr 300 Fig. 5.16 In a dilute solution, the solvent molecules (the purple spheres) are in an environment that differs only slightly from that of the pure solvent. The solute particles, however, are in an environment totally unlike that of the pure solute. Fig. 5.17 The experimental partial vapour pressures of a mixture of chloroform (trichloromethane) and acetone (propanone) based on the data in Example 5.3. The values of K are obtained by extrapolating the dilute solution vapour pressures as explained in the Example. pB = xBKB (5.26)° In this expression xB is the mole fraction of the solute and KB is an empirical constant (with the dimensions of pressure) chosen so that the plot of the vapour pressure of B against its mole fraction is tangent to the experimental curve at xB = 0. Mixtures for which the solute obeys Henry’s law and the solvent obeys Raoult’s law are called ideal-dilute solutions. We shall also label equations with a superscript ° when they have been derived from Henry’s law. The difference in behaviour of the solute and solvent at low concentrations (as expressed by Henry’s and Raoult’s laws, respectively) arises from the fact that in a dilute solution the solvent molecules are in an environment very much like the one they have in the pure liquid (Fig. 5.16). In contrast, the solute molecules are surrounded by solvent molecules, which is entirely different from their environment when pure. Thus, the solvent behaves like a slightly modified pure liquid, but the solute behaves entirely differently from its pure state unless the solvent and solute molecules happen to be very similar. In the latter case, the solute also obeys Raoult’s law. Example 5.3 Investigating the validity of Raoult’s and Henry’s laws The vapour pressures of each component in a mixture of propanone (acetone, A) and trichloromethane (chloroform, C) were measured at 35°C with the following results: xC 0 0.20 0.40 0.60 0.80 1 pC/kPa 0 4.7 11 18.9 26.7 36.4 pA/kPa 46.3 33.3 23.3 12.3 4.9 0 Confirm that the mixture conforms to Raoult’s law for the component in large excess and to Henry’s law for the minor component. Find the Henry’s law constants. Method Both Raoult’s and Henry’s laws are statements about the form of the graph of partial vapour pressure against mole fraction. Therefore, plot the partial vapour pressures against mole fraction. Raoult’s law is tested by comparing the data with the straight line pJ = xJpJ* for each component in the region in which it is in excess (and acting as the solvent). Henry’s law is tested by finding a straight line pJ = xJKJ that is tangent to each partial vapour pressure at low x, where the component can be treated as the solute. Answer The data are plotted in Fig. 5.17 together with the Raoult’s law lines. Henry’s law requires K = 23.3 kPa for propanone and K = 22.0 kPa for trichloromethane. Notice how the system deviates from both Raoult’s and Henry’s laws even for quite small departures from x = 1 and x = 0, respectively. We deal with these deviations in Section 5.5. Self-test 5.4 The vapour pressure of chloromethane at various mole fractions in a mixture at 25°C was found to be as follows: x 0.005 0.009 0.019 0.024 p/kPa 27.3 48.4 101 126 Estimate Henry’s law constant. [5 MPa] For practical applications, Henry’s law is expressed in terms of the molality, b, of the solute, 5.3 THE CHEMICAL POTENTIALS OF LIQUIDS 147 Synoptic Table 5.1* Henry’s law constants for gases in water at 298 K K/(kPa kg mol−1 ) CO2 3.01 × 103 H2 1.28 × 105 N2 1.56 × 105 O2 7.92 × 104 * More values are given in the Data section. Comment 5.2 The web site contains links to online databases of Henry’s law constants. pB = bBKB Some Henry’s law data for this convention are listed in Table 5.1. As well as providing a link between the mole fraction of solute and its partial pressure, the data in the table may also be used to calculate gas solubilities. A knowledge of Henry’s law constants for gases in blood and fats is important for the discussion of respiration, especially when the partial pressure of oxygen is abnormal, as in diving and mountaineering, and for the discussion of the action of gaseous anaesthetics. Illustration 5.2 Using Henry’s law To estimate the molar solubility of oxygen in water at 25°C and a partial pressure of 21 kPa, its partial pressure in the atmosphere at sea level, we write bO2 = = = 2.9 × 10−4 mol kg−1 The molality of the saturated solution is therefore 0.29 mmol kg−1 . To convert this quantity to a molar concentration, we assume that the mass density of this dilute solution is essentially that of pure water at 25°C, or ρH2O = 0.99709 kg dm−3 . It follows that the molar concentration of oxygen is [O2] = bO2 × ρH2O = 0.29 mmol kg−1 × 0.99709 kg dm−3 = 0.29 mmol dm−3 A note on good practice The number of significant figures in the result of a calculation should not exceed the number in the data (only two in this case). Self-test 5.5 Calculate the molar solubility of nitrogen in water exposed to air at 25°C; partial pressures were calculated in Example 1.3. [0.51 mmol dm−3 ] IMPACT ON BIOLOGY I5.1 Gas solubility and breathing We inhale about 500 cm3 of air with each breath we take. The influx of air is a result of changes in volume of the lungs as the diaphragm is depressed and the chest expands, which results in a decrease in pressure of about 100 Pa relative to atmospheric pressure. Expiration occurs as the diaphragm rises and the chest contracts, and gives rise to a differential pressure of about 100 Pa above atmospheric pressure. The total volume of air in the lungs is about 6 dm3 , and the additional volume of air that can be exhaled forcefully after normal expiration is about 1.5 dm3 . Some air remains in the lungs at all times to prevent the collapse of the alveoli. A knowledge of Henry’s law constants for gases in fats and lipids is important for the discussion of respiration. The effect of gas exchange between blood and air inside the alveoli of the lungs means that the composition of the air in the lungs changes throughout the breathing cycle. Alveolar gas is in fact a mixture of newly inhaled air and air about to be exhaled. The concentration of oxygen present in arterial blood is equivalent to a partial pressure of about 40 Torr (5.3 kPa), whereas the partial pressure of freshly inhaled air is about 104 Torr (13.9 kPa). Arterial blood remains in the capillary passing through the wall of an alveolus for about 0.75 s, but such is the steepness of the pressure gradient that it becomes fully saturated with oxygen in about 0.25 s. If the lungs collect fluids (as in pneumonia), then the respiratory membrane thickens, diffusion is greatly slowed, and body tissues begin to suffer from oxygen starvation. Carbon dioxide moves in the opposite direction across the respiratory 21 kPa 7.9 × 104 kPa kg mol−1 pO2 KO2 148 5 SIMPLE MIXTURES tissue, but the partial pressure gradient is much less, corresponding to about 5 Torr (0.7 kPa) in blood and 40 Torr (5.3 kPa) in air at equilibrium. However, because carbon dioxide is much more soluble in the alveolar fluid than oxygen is, equal amounts of oxygen and carbon dioxide are exchanged in each breath. A hyperbaric oxygen chamber, in which oxygen is at an elevated partial pressure, is used to treat certain types of disease. Carbon monoxide poisoning can be treated in this way as can the consequences of shock. Diseases that are caused by anaerobic bacteria, such as gas gangrene and tetanus, can also be treated because the bacteria cannot thrive in high oxygen concentrations. In scuba diving (where scuba is an acronym formed from ‘self-contained underwater breathing apparatus’), air is supplied at a higher pressure, so that the pressure within the diver’s chest matches the pressure exerted by the surrounding water. The latter increases by about 1 atm for each 10 m of descent. One unfortunate consequence of breathing air at high pressures is that nitrogen is much more soluble in fatty tissues than in water, so it tends to dissolve in the central nervous system, bone marrow, and fat reserves. The result is nitrogen narcosis, with symptoms like intoxication. If the diver rises too rapidly to the surface, the nitrogen comes out of its lipid solution as bubbles, which causes the painful and sometimes fatal condition known as the bends. Many cases of scuba drowning appear to be consequences of arterial embolisms (obstructions in arteries caused by gas bubbles) and loss of consciousness as the air bubbles rise into the head. The properties of solutions In this section we consider the thermodynamics of mixing of liquids. First, we consider the simple case of mixtures of liquids that mix to form an ideal solution. In this way, we identify the thermodynamic consequences of molecules of one species mingling randomly with molecules of the second species. The calculation provides a background for discussing the deviations from ideal behaviour exhibited by real solutions. 5.4 Liquid mixtures Thermodynamics can provide insight into the properties of liquid mixtures, and a few simple ideas can bring the whole field of study together. (a) Ideal solutions The Gibbs energy of mixing of two liquids to form an ideal solution is calculated in exactly the same way as for two gases (Section 5.2). The total Gibbs energy before liquids are mixed is Gi = nAµA* + nBµB* When they are mixed, the individual chemical potentials are given by eqn 5.25 and the total Gibbs energy is Gf = nA{µA* + RT ln xA} + nB{µB* +RT ln xB} Consequently, the Gibbs energy of mixing is ∆mixG = nRT{xA ln xA + xB ln xB} (5.27)° where n = nA + nB. As for gases, it follows that the ideal entropy of mixing of two liquids is ∆mixS = −nR{xA ln xA + xB ln xB} (5.28)° 5.4 LIQUID MIXTURES 149 and, because ∆mixH = ∆mixG + T∆mixS = 0, the ideal enthalpy of mixing is zero. The ideal volume of mixing, the change in volume on mixing, is also zero because it follows from eqn 3.50 ((∂G/∂p)T = V) that ∆mixV = (∂∆mixG/∂p)T, but ∆mixG in eqn 5.27 is independent of pressure, so the derivative with respect to pressure is zero. Equation 5.27 is the same as that for two perfect gases and all the conclusions drawn there are valid here: the driving force for mixing is the increasing entropy of the system as the molecules mingle and the enthalpy of mixing is zero. It should be noted, however, that solution ideality means something different from gas perfection. In a perfect gas there are no forces acting between molecules. In ideal solutions there are interactions, but the average energy of A-B interactions in the mixture is the same as the average energy of A-A and B-B interactions in the pure liquids.2 The variation of the Gibbs energy of mixing with composition is the same as that already depicted for gases in Fig. 5.7; the same is true of the entropy of mixing, Fig. 5.9. Real solutions are composed of particles for which A-A, A-B, and B-B interactions are all different. Not only may there be enthalpy and volume changes when liquids mix, but there may also be an additional contribution to the entropy arising from the way in which the molecules of one type might cluster together instead of mingling freely with the others. If the enthalpy change is large and positive or if the entropy change is adverse (because of a reorganization of the molecules that results in an orderly mixture), then the Gibbs energy might be positive for mixing. In that case, separation is spontaneous and the liquids may be immiscible. Alternatively, the liquids might be partially miscible, which means that they are miscible only over a certain range of compositions. (b) Excess functions and regular solutions The thermodynamic properties of real solutions are expressed in terms of the excess functions, XE , the difference between the observed thermodynamic function of mixing and the function for an ideal solution. The excess entropy, SE , for example, is defined as SE = ∆mixS − ∆mixSideal [5.29] where ∆mixSideal is given by eqn 5.28. The excess enthalpy and volume are both equal to the observed enthalpy and volume of mixing, because the ideal values are zero in each case. Deviations of the excess energies from zero indicate the extent to which the solutions are nonideal. In this connection a useful model system is the regular solution, a solution for which HE ≠ 0 but SE = 0. We can think of a regular solution as one in which the two kinds of molecules are distributed randomly (as in an ideal solution) but have different energies of interactions with each other. Figure 5.18 shows two examples of the composition dependence of molar excess functions. We can make this discussion more quantitative by supposing that the excess enthalpy depends on composition as HE = nβRTxAxB (5.30) where β is a dimensionless parameter that is a measure of the energy of AB interactions relative to that of the AA and BB interactions. The function given by eqn 5.30 is plotted in Fig. 5.19, and we see it resembles the experimental curve in Fig. 5.18. If β < 0, mixing is exothermic and the solute–solvent interactions are more favourable than the solvent–solvent and solute–solute interactions. If β > 0, then the mixing is 0 0 0.5 0.5 1 1 x(C H )6 6 x(C Cl )2 4 0 400 800 HE–1 /(Jmol)VE3–1 /(mmmol) –12 –4 –8 0 4 8 (a) (b) Fig. 5.18 Experimental excess functions at 25°C. (a) HE for benzene/cyclohexane; this graph shows that the mixing is endothermic (because ∆mixH = 0 for an ideal solution). (b) The excess volume, VE , for tetrachloroethene/cyclopentane; this graph shows that there is a contraction at low tetrachloroethane mole fractions, but an expansion at high mole fractions (because ∆mixV = 0 for an ideal mixture).2 It is on the basis of this distinction that the term ‘perfect gas’ is preferable to the more common ‘ideal gas’. 150 5 SIMPLE MIXTURES endothermic. Because the entropy of mixing has its ideal value for a regular solution, the excess Gibbs energy is equal to the excess enthalpy, and the Gibbs energy of mixing is ∆mixG = nRT{xA ln xA + xB ln xB + βxAxB} (5.31) Figure 5.20 shows how ∆mixG varies with composition for different values of β. The important feature is that for β > 2 the graph shows two minima separated by a maximum. The implication of this observation is that, provided β > 2, then the system will separate spontaneously into two phases with compositions corresponding to the two minima, for that separation corresponds to a reduction in Gibbs energy. We develop this point in Sections 5.8 and 6.5. 5.5 Colligative properties The properties we now consider are the lowering of vapour pressure, the elevation of boiling point, the depression of freezing point, and the osmotic pressure arising from the presence of a solute. In dilute solutions these properties depend only on the number of solute particles present, not their identity. For this reason, they are called colligative properties (denoting ‘depending on the collection’). We assume throughout the following that the solute is not volatile, so it does not contribute to the vapour. We also assume that the solute does not dissolve in the solid solvent: that is, the pure solid solvent separates when the solution is frozen. The latter assumption is quite drastic, although it is true of many mixtures; it can be avoided at the expense of more algebra, but that introduces no new principles. (a) The common features of colligative properties All the colligative properties stem from the reduction of the chemical potential of the liquid solvent as a result of the presence of solute. For an ideal-dilute solution, the +0.5 0 -0.5HnRTE / 0 0.5 1 xA -2 -1 0 1 2 0 DmixGnRT/ 0 0.5 1 xA 1 1.5 2 2.5 3 -0.5 -0.4 -0.3 -0.2 -0.1 +0.1 Fig. 5.19 The excess enthalpy according to a model in which it is proportional to βxAxB, for different values of the parameter β. Exploration Using the graph above, fix β and vary the temperature. For what value of xA does the excess enthalpy depend on temperature most strongly? Fig. 5.20 The Gibbs energy of mixing for different values of the parameter β. Exploration Using the graph above, fix β at 1.5 and vary the temperature. Is there a range of temperatures over which you observe phase separation? 5.5 COLLIGATIVE PROPERTIES 151 Chemicalpotential, Tf Tf Tb Tb Freezing point depression Boiling point elevation Solid Pure liquid Vapour Solution m ´ ´ Fig. 5.21 The chemical potential of a solvent in the presence of a solute. The lowering of the liquid’s chemical potential has a greater effect on the freezing point than on the boiling point because of the angles at which the lines intersect. pA* pA (b)(a) Fig. 5.22 The vapour pressure of a pure liquid represents a balance between the increase in disorder arising from vaporization and the decrease in disorder of the surroundings. (a) Here the structure of the liquid is represented highly schematically by the grid of squares. (b) When solute (the dark squares) is present, the disorder of the condensed phase is higher than that of the pure liquid, and there is a decreased tendency to acquire the disorder characteristic of the vapour. reduction is from µA* for the pure solvent to µA* + RT ln xA when a solute is present (ln xA is negative because xA < 1). There is no direct influence of the solute on the chemical potential of the solvent vapour and the solid solvent because the solute appears in neither the vapour nor the solid. As can be seen from Fig. 5.21, the reduction in chemical potential of the solvent implies that the liquid–vapour equilibrium occurs at a higher temperature (the boiling point is raised) and the solid–liquid equilibrium occurs at a lower temperature (the freezing point is lowered). Molecular interpretation 5.2 The lowering of vapour pressure of a solvent in a mixture The molecular origin of the lowering of the chemical potential is not the energy of interaction of the solute and solvent particles, because the lowering occurs even in an ideal solution (for which the enthalpy of mixing is zero). If it is not an enthalpy effect, it must be an entropy effect. The pure liquid solvent has an entropy that reflects the number of microstates available to its molecules. Its vapour pressure reflects the tendency of the solution towards greater entropy, which can be achieved if the liquid vaporizes to form a gas. When a solute is present, there is an additional contribution to the entropy of the liquid, even in an ideal solution. Because the entropy of the liquid is already higher than that of the pure liquid, there is a weaker tendency to form the gas (Fig. 5.22). The effect of the solute appears as a lowered vapour pressure, and hence a higher boiling point. Similarly, the enhanced molecular randomness of the solution opposes the tendency to freeze. Consequently, a lower temperature must be reached before equilibrium between solid and solution is achieved. Hence, the freezing point is lowered. The strategy for the quantitative discussion of the elevation of boiling point and the depression of freezing point is to look for the temperature at which, at 1 atm, one phase (the pure solvent vapour or the pure solid solvent) has the same chemical potential as the solvent in the solution. This is the new equilibrium temperature for the phase transition at 1 atm, and hence corresponds to the new boiling point or the new freezing point of the solvent. (b) The elevation of boiling point The heterogeneous equilibrium of interest when considering boiling is between the solvent vapour and the solvent in solution at 1 atm (Fig. 5.23). We denote the solvent by A and the solute by B. The equilibrium is established at a temperature for which µA*(g) = µA*(l) + RT ln xA (5.32)° (The pressure of 1 atm is the same throughout, and will not be written explicitly.) We show in the Justification below that this equation implies that the presence of a solute at a mole fraction xB causes an increase in normal boiling point from T* to T* + ∆T, where ∆T = KxB K = (5.33)° RT*2 ∆vapH 152 5 SIMPLE MIXTURES Justification 5.1 The elevation of the boiling point of a solvent Equation 5.32 can be rearranged into ln xA = = where ∆vapG is the Gibbs energy of vaporization of the pure solvent (A). First, to find the relation between a change in composition and the resulting change in boiling temperature, we differentiate both sides with respect to temperature and use the Gibbs–Helmholtz equation (eqn 3.52, (∂(G/T)/∂T)p = −H/T2 ) to express the term on the right: = = − Now multiply both sides by dT and integrate from xA = 1, corresponding to ln xA = 0 (and when T = T*, the boiling point of pure A) to xA (when the boiling point is T): Ύ0 lnxA d ln xA = − Ύ T T* dT The left-hand side integrates to ln xA, which is equal to ln(1 − xB). The right-hand side can be integrated if we assume that the enthalpy of vaporization is a constant over the small range of temperatures involved and can be taken outside the integral. Thus, we obtain ln(1 − xB) = − We now suppose that the amount of solute present is so small that xB << 1. We can then write ln(1 − xB ) ≈ −xB and hence obtain xB = − Finally, because T ≈ T*, it also follows that − = ≈ with ∆T = T − T*. The previous equation then rearranges into eqn 5.33. Because eqn 5.33 makes no reference to the identity of the solute, only to its mole fraction, we conclude that the elevation of boiling point is a colligative property. The value of ∆T does depend on the properties of the solvent, and the biggest changes occur for solvents with high boiling points.3 For practical applications of eqn 5.33, we note that the mole fraction of B is proportional to its molality, b, in the solution, and write ∆T = Kbb (5.34) where Kb is the empirical boiling-point constant of the solvent (Table 5.2). (c) The depression of freezing point The heterogeneous equilibrium now of interest is between pure solid solvent A and the solution with solute present at a mole fraction xB (Fig. 5.24). At the freezing point, the chemical potentials of A in the two phases are equal: ∆T T*2 T − T* TT* 1 T 1 T* D E F 1 T 1 T* A B C ∆vapH R D E F 1 T* 1 T A B C ∆vapH R ∆vapH T2 1 R ∆vapH RT2 d(∆vapG/T) dT 1 R d ln xA dT ∆vapG RT µA*(g) − µA*(l) RT A(g) A*(g, )p A(l) A(l) + B Equal at equilibrium m m Fig. 5.23 The heterogeneous equilibrium involved in the calculation of the elevation of boiling point is between A in the pure vapour and A in the mixture, A being the solvent and B an involatile solute. Comment 5.3 The series expansion of a natural logarithm (see Appendix 2) is ln(1 − x) = −x − 1–2x2 − 1–3 x3 · · · provided that −1 < x < 1. If x << 1, then the terms involving x raised to a power greater than 1 are much smaller than x, so ln(1 − x) ≈ −x. 3 By Trouton’s rule (Section 3.3b), ∆vapH/T* is a constant; therefore eqn 5.33 has the form ∆T ∝ T* and is independent of ∆vapH itself. A(s) A*(s) A(l) A(l) + B Equal at equilibrium m m Fig. 5.24 The heterogeneous equilibrium involved in the calculation of the lowering of freezing point is between A in the pure solid and A in the mixture, A being the solvent and B a solute that is insoluble in solid A. 5.5 COLLIGATIVE PROPERTIES 153 µA*(s) = µA*(l) + RT ln xA (5.35)° The only difference between this calculation and the last is the appearance of the solid’s chemical potential in place of the vapour’s. Therefore we can write the result directly from eqn 5.33: ∆T = K′xB K′ = (5.36)° where ∆T is the freezing point depression, T* − T, and ∆fusH is the enthalpy of fusion of the solvent. Larger depressions are observed in solvents with low enthalpies of fusion and high melting points. When the solution is dilute, the mole fraction is proportional to the molality of the solute, b, and it is common to write the last equation as ∆T = Kfb (5.37) where Kf is the empirical freezing-point constant (Table 5.2). Once the freezingpoint constant of a solvent is known, the depression of freezing point may be used to measure the molar mass of a solute in the method known as cryoscopy; however, the technique is of little more than historical interest. (d) Solubility Although solubility is not strictly a colligative property (because solubility varies with the identity of the solute), it may be estimated by the same techniques as we have been using. When a solid solute is left in contact with a solvent, it dissolves until the solution is saturated. Saturation is a state of equilibrium, with the undissolved solute in equilibrium with the dissolved solute. Therefore, in a saturated solution the chemical potential of the pure solid solute, µB*(s), and the chemical potential of B in solution, µB, are equal (Fig. 5.25). Because the latter is µB = µB*(l) + RT ln xB we can write µB*(s) = µB*(l) + RT ln xB (5.38)° This expression is the same as the starting equation of the last section, except that the quantities refer to the solute B, not the solvent A. We now show in the following Justification that ln xB = − (5.39)° D F 1 T 1 Tf A C ∆fusH R RT*2 ∆fusH Synoptic Table 5.2* Freezing-point and boiling-point constants Kf /(K kg mol−1 ) Kb/(K kg mol−1 ) Benzene 5.12 2.53 Camphor 40 Phenol 7.27 3.04 Water 1.86 0.51 * More values are given in the Data section. B(s) B*(s) B(solution) Equal at equilibrium B(dissolved in A) m m Fig. 5.25 The heterogeneous equilibrium involved in the calculation of the solubility is between pure solid B and B in the mixture. 154 5 SIMPLE MIXTURES Justification 5.2 The solubility of an ideal solute. The starting point is the same as in Justification 5.1 but the aim is different. In the present case, we want to find the mole fraction of B in solution at equilibrium when the temperature is T. Therefore, we start by rearranging eqn 5.38 into ln xB = = − As in Justification 5.1, we relate the change in composition d ln xB to the change in temperature by differentiation and use of the Gibbs–Helmholtz equation. Then we integrate from the melting temperature of B (when xB = 1 and ln xB = 0) to the lower temperature of interest (when xB has a value between 0 and 1): Ύ0 ln xB d ln xB = Ύ T Tf dT If we suppose that the enthalpy of fusion of B is constant over the range of temperatures of interest, it can be taken outside the integral, and we obtain eqn 5.39. Equation 5.39 is plotted in Fig. 5.26. It shows that the solubility of B decreases exponentially as the temperature is lowered from its melting point. The illustration also shows that solutes with high melting points and large enthalpies of melting have low solubilities at normal temperatures. However, the detailed content of eqn 5.39 should not be treated too seriously because it is based on highly questionable approximations, such as the ideality of the solution. One aspect of its approximate character is that it fails to predict that solutes will have different solubilities in different solvents, for no solvent properties appear in the expression. (e) Osmosis The phenomenon of osmosis (from the Greek word for ‘push’) is the spontaneous passage of a pure solvent into a solution separated from it by a semipermeable membrane, a membrane permeable to the solvent but not to the solute (Fig. 5.27). The osmotic pressure, Π, is the pressure that must be applied to the solution to stop the influx of solvent. Important examples of osmosis include transport of fluids through cell membranes, dialysis and osmometry, the determination of molar mass by the measurement of osmotic pressure. Osmometry is widely used to determine the molar masses of macromolecules. In the simple arrangement shown in Fig. 5.28, the opposing pressure arises from the head of solution that the osmosis itself produces. Equilibrium is reached when the hydrostatic pressure of the column of solution matches the osmotic pressure. The complicating feature of this arrangement is that the entry of solvent into the solution results in its dilution, and so it is more difficult to treat than the arrangement in Fig. 5.27, in which there is no flow and the concentrations remain unchanged. The thermodynamic treatment of osmosis depends on noting that, at equilibrium, the chemical potential of the solvent must be the same on each side of the membrane. The chemical potential of the solvent is lowered by the solute, but is restored to its ‘pure’ value by the application of pressure. As shown in the Justification below, this equality implies that for dilute solutions the osmotic pressure is given by the van ’t Hoff equation: Π = [B]RT (5.40)° where [B] = nB/V is the molar concentration of the solute. ∆fusH T2 1 R ∆fusG RT µB*(s) − µB*(l) RT 10 3 1 0.3 0.1 0 0.5 1 T T/ * 0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1 MolefractionofB,xB Fig. 5.26 The variation of solubility (the mole fraction of solute in a saturated solution) with temperature (T* is the freezing temperature of the solute). Individual curves are labelled with the value of ∆fusH/RT*. Exploration Derive an expression for the temperature coefficient of the solubility, dxB/dT, and plot it as a function of temperature for several values of the enthalpy of fusion. p p + A*( )p A( + )p Equal at equilibrium Pure solvent Solution P mm P Fig. 5.27 The equilibrium involved in the calculation of osmotic pressure, Π, is between pure solvent A at a pressure p on one side of the semipermeable membrane and A as a component of the mixture on the other side of the membrane, where the pressure is p + Π. 5.5 COLLIGATIVE PROPERTIES 155 4 We have denoted the solute J to avoid too many different Bs in this expression. Justification 5.3 The van ’t Hoff equation On the pure solvent side the chemical potential of the solvent, which is at a pressure p, is µA*(p). On the solution side, the chemical potential is lowered by the presence of the solute, which reduces the mole fraction of the solvent from 1 to xA. However, the chemical potential of A is raised on account of the greater pressure, p + Π, that the solution experiences. At equilibrium the chemical potential of A is the same in both compartments, and we can write µA*(p) = µA(xA, p + Π) The presence of solute is taken into account in the normal way: µA(xA, p + Π) = µA*(p + Π) + RT ln xA We saw in Section 3.9c (eqn 3.54) how to take the effect of pressure into account: µA*(p + Π) = µA*(p) + Ύp p+Π Vmdp where Vm is the molar volume of the pure solvent A. When these three equations are combined we get −RT lnxA = Ύp p+Π Vmdp This expression enables us to calculate the additional pressure Π that must be applied to the solution to restore the chemical potential of the solvent to its ‘pure’ value and thus to restore equilibrium across the semipermeable membrane. For dilute solutions, ln xA may be replaced by ln (1 − xB) ≈ −xB. We may also assume that the pressure range in the integration is so small that the molar volume of the solvent is a constant. That being so, Vm may be taken outside the integral, giving RTxB = ΠVm When the solution is dilute, xB ≈ nB/nA. Moreover, because nAVm = V, the total volume of the solvent, the equation simplifies to eqn 5.40. Because the effect of osmotic pressure is so readily measurable and large, one of the most common applications of osmometry is to the measurement of molar masses of macromolecules, such as proteins and synthetic polymers. As these huge molecules dissolve to produce solutions that are far from ideal, it is assumed that the van ’t Hoff equation is only the first term of a virial-like expansion:4 Π = [J]RT{1 + B[J] + · · · } (5.41) The additional terms take the nonideality into account; the empirical constant B is called the osmotic virial coefficient. Example 5.4 Using osmometry to determine the molar mass of a macromolecule The osmotic pressures of solutions of poly(vinyl chloride), PVC, in cyclohexanone at 298 K are given below. The pressures are expressed in terms of the heights of solution (of mass density ρ = 0.980 g cm−3 ) in balance with the osmotic pressure. Determine the molar mass of the polymer. c/(g dm−3 ) 1.00 2.00 4.00 7.00 9.00 h/cm 0.28 0.71 2.01 5.10 8.00 156 5 SIMPLE MIXTURES Method The osmotic pressure is measured at a series of mass concentrations, c, and a plot of Π/c against c is used to determine the molar mass of the polymer. We use eqn 5.41 with [J] = c/M where c is the mass concentration of the polymer and M is its molar mass. The osmotic pressure is related to the hydrostatic pressure by Π = ρgh (Example 1.2) with g = 9.81 m s−2 . With these substitutions, eqn 5.41 becomes = 1 + + · · · = + c + · · · Therefore, to find M, plot h/c against c, and expect a straight line with intercept RT/ρgM at c = 0. Answer The data give the following values for the quantities to plot: c/(g dm−3 ) 1.00 2.00 4.00 7.00 9.00 (h/c)/(cm g−1 dm3 ) 0.28 0.36 0.503 0.729 0.889 The points are plotted in Fig. 5.28. The intercept is at 0.21. Therefore, M = × = × = 1.2 × 102 kg mol−1 where we have used 1 kg m2 s−2 = 1 J. Molar masses of macromolecules are often reported in daltons (Da), with 1 Da = 1 g mol−1 . The macromolecule in this example has a molar mass of about 120 kDa. Modern osmometers give readings of osmotic pressure in pascals, so the analysis of the data is more straightforward and eqn 5.41 can be used directly. As we shall see in Chapter 19, the value obtained from osmometry is the ‘number average molar mass’. Self-test 5.6 Estimate the depression of freezing point of the most concentrated of these solutions, taking Kf as about 10 K/(mol kg−1 ). [0.8 mK] IMPACT ON BIOLOGY I5.2 Osmosis in physiology and biochemistry Osmosis helps biological cells maintain their structure. Cell membranes are semipermeable and allow water, small molecules, and hydrated ions to pass, while blocking the passage of biopolymers synthesized inside the cell. The difference in concentrations of solutes inside and outside the cell gives rise to an osmotic pressure, and water passes into the more concentrated solution in the interior of the cell, carrying small nutrient molecules. The influx of water also keeps the cell swollen, whereas dehydration causes the cell to shrink. These effects are important in everyday medical practice. To maintain the integrity of blood cells, solutions that are injected into the bloodstream for blood transfusions and intravenous feeding must be isotonic with the blood, meaning that they must have the same osmotic pressure as blood. If the injected solution is too dilute, or hypotonic, the flow of solvent into the cells, required to equalize the osmotic pressure, causes the cells to burst and die by a process called haemolysis. If the solution is too concentrated, or hypertonic, equalization of the osmotic pressure requires flow of solvent out of the cells, which shrink and die. 1 2.1 × 10−3 m4 kg−1 (8.3145 J K−1 mol−1 ) × (298 K) (980 kg m−3 ) × (9.81 m s−2 ) 1 0.21 cm g−1 dm3 RT ρg D F RTB ρgM2 A C RT ρgM D F Bc M A C RT ρgM h c 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 0 2 4 6 8 10 (/)/(cmgdm)hc13 c/(g dm )-3 Fig. 5.28 The plot involved in the determination of molar mass by osmometry. The molar mass is calculated from the intercept at c = 0; in Chapter 19 we shall see that additional information comes from the slope. Exploration Calculate the osmotic virial coefficient B from these data. Solution Solvent Semipermeable membrane Height proportional to osmotic pressure Fig. 5.29 In a simple version of the osmotic pressure experiment, A is at equilibrium on each side of the membrane when enough has passed into the solution to cause a hydrostatic pressure difference. 5.5 COLLIGATIVE PROPERTIES 157 Osmosis also forms the basis of dialysis, a common technique for the removal of impurities from solutions of biological macromolecules and for the study of binding of small molecules to macromolecules, such as an inhibitor to an enzyme, an antibiotic to DNA, and any other instance of cooperation or inhibition by small molecules attaching to large ones. In a purification experiment, a solution of macromolecules containing impurities, such as ions or small molecules (including small proteins or nucleic acids), is placed in a bag made of a material that acts as a semipermeable membrane and the filled bag is immersed in a solvent. The membrane permits the passage of the small ions and molecules but not the larger macromolecules, so the former migrate through the membrane, leaving the macromolecules behind. In practice, purification of the sample requires several changes of solvent to coax most of the impurities out of the dialysis bag. In a binding experiment, a solution of macromolecules and smaller ions or molecules is placed in a dialysis bag, which is then immersed in a solvent. Suppose the molar concentration of the macromolecule M is [M] and the total concentration of the small molecule A in the bag is [A]in. This total concentration is the sum of the concentrations of free A and bound A, which we write [A]free and [A]bound, respectively. At equilibrium, the chemical potential of free A in the macromolecule solution is equal to the chemical potential of A in the solution on the other side of the membrane, where its concentration is [A]out. We shall see in Section 5.7 that the equality µA,free = µA,out implies that [A]free = [A]out, provided the activity coefficient of A is the same in both solutions. Therefore, by measuring the concentration of A in the ‘outside’ solution, we can find the concentration of unbound A in the macromolecule solution and, from the difference [A]in − [A]free, which is equal to [A]in − [A]out, the concentration of bound A. The average number of A molecules bound to M molecules, ν, is then the ratio ν = = The bound and unbound A molecules are in equilibrium, M + A 5 MA, so their concentrations are related by an equilibrium constant K, where K = = We have used [MA] = [A]bound and [M]free = [M] − [MA] = [M] − [A]bound. On division by [M], and replacement of [A]free by [A]out, the last expression becomes K = If there are N identical and independent binding sites on each macromolecule, each macromolecule behaves like N separate smaller macromolecules, with the same value of K for each site. The average number of A molecules per site is ν/N, so the last equation becomes K = 1 − [A]out It then follows that = KN − Kν ν [A]out D F ν N A C ν/N ν (1 − ν)[A]out [A]bound ([M] − [A]bound)[A]free [MA] [M]free[A]free [A]in − [A]out [M] [A]bound [M] 158 5 SIMPLE MIXTURES Table 5.3 Standard states Component Basis Standard state Activity Limits Solid or liquid Pure a = 1 Solvent Raoult Pure solvent a = p/p*, a = γx γ → 1 as x → 1 (pure solvent) Solute Henry (1) A hypothetical state of a = p/K, a = γx γ → 1 as x → 0 the pure solute (2) A hypothetical state of a = γb/b7 γ → 1 as b → 0 the solute at molality b7 In each case, µ = µ7 + RT ln a. This expression is the Scatchard equation. It implies that a plot of ν/[A]out against v should be a straight line of slope −K and intercept KN at ν = 0 (see Fig. 5.30). From these two quantities, we can find the equilibrium constant for binding and the number of binding sites on each macromolecule. If a straight line is not obtained we can conclude that the binding sites are not equivalent or independent. Activities Now we see how to adjust the expressions developed earlier in the chapter to take into account deviations from ideal behaviour. In Chapter 3 (specifically, Further information 3.2) we remarked that a quantity called ‘fugacity’ takes into account the effects of gas imperfections in a manner that resulted in the least upset of the form of equations. Here we see how the expressions encountered in the treatment of ideal solutions can also be preserved almost intact by introducing the concept of ‘activity’. It is important to be aware of the different definitions of standard states and activities, and they are summarized in Table 5.3. We shall put them to work in the next few chapters, when we shall see that using them is much easier than defining them. 5.6 The solvent activity The general form of the chemical potential of a real or ideal solvent is given by a straightforward modification of eqn 5.23 (that µA = µA* + RT ln(pA/pA*), where pA* is the vapour pressure of pure A and pA is the vapour pressure of A when it is a component of a solution. For an ideal solution, as we have seen, the solvent obeys Raoult’s law at all concentrations and we can express this relation as eqn 5.25 (that is, as µA = µA* + RT ln xA). The form of the this relation can be preserved when the solution does not obey Raoult’s law by writing µA = µA* + RT ln aA [5.42] The quantity aA is the activity of A, a kind of ‘effective’ mole fraction, just as the fugacity is an effective pressure. Because eqn 5.23 is true for both real and ideal solutions (the only approximation being the use of pressures rather than fugacities), we can conclude by comparing it with eqn 5.42 that aA = (5.43) pA pA* Number of binding sites, /[A]out Intercept = KN Intercept = N Slope = -K n n Fig. 5.30 A Scatchard plot of ν/[A]out against ν. The slope is –K and the intercept at ν = 0 is KN. Exploration The following tasks will give you an idea of how graphical analysis can distinguish between systems with the same values of K or N. First, display on the same graph several Scatchard plots with varying K values but fixed N. Then repeat the process, this time varying N but fixing K. 5.7 THE SOLUTE ACTIVITY 159 We see that there is nothing mysterious about the activity of a solvent: it can be determined experimentally simply by measuring the vapour pressure and then using eqn 5.43. Illustration 5.3 Calculating the solvent activity The vapour pressure of 0.500 M KNO3(aq) at 100°C is 99.95 kPa, so the activity of water in the solution at this temperature is aA = = 0.9864 Because all solvents obey Raoult’s law (that pA/pA* = xA) increasingly closely as the concentration of solute approaches zero, the activity of the solvent approaches the mole fraction as xA → 1: aA → xA as xA → 1 (5.44) A convenient way of expressing this convergence is to introduce the activity coefficient, γ, by the definition aA = γAxA γA → 1 as xA → 1 [5.45] at all temperatures and pressures. The chemical potential of the solvent is then µA = µA* + RT ln xA + RT ln γA (5.46) The standard state of the solvent, the pure liquid solvent at 1 bar, is established when xA = 1. 5.7 The solute activity The problem with defining activity coefficients and standard states for solutes is that they approach ideal-dilute (Henry’s law) behaviour as xB → 0, not as xB → 1 (corresponding to pure solute). We shall show how to set up the definitions for a solute that obeys Henry’s law exactly, and then show how to allow for deviations. (a) Ideal-dilute solutions A solute B that satisfies Henry’s law has a vapour pressure given by pB = KBxB, where KB is an empirical constant. In this case, the chemical potential of B is µB = µB* + RT ln = µB* + RT ln + RT lnxB Both KB and pB* are characteristics of the solute, so the second term may be combined with the first to give a new standard chemical potential: µB 7 = µB* + RT ln [5.47] It then follows that the chemical potential of a solute in an ideal-dilute solution is related to its mole fraction by µB = µB 7 + RT ln xB (5.48)° If the solution is ideal, KB = pB* and eqn 5.47 reduces to µB 7 = µB*, as we should expect. KB pB* KB pB* pB pB* 99.95 kPa 101.325 kPa 160 5 SIMPLE MIXTURES (b) Real solutes We now permit deviations from ideal-dilute, Henry’s law behaviour. For the solute, we introduce aB in place of xB in eqn 5.48, and obtain µB = µB 7 + RT ln aB [5.49] The standard state remains unchanged in this last stage, and all the deviations from ideality are captured in the activity aB. The value of the activity at any concentration can be obtained in the same way as for the solvent, but in place of eqn 5.43 we use aB = (5.50) As for the solvent, it is sensible to introduce an activity coefficient through aB = γBxB [5.51] Now all the deviations from ideality are captured in the activity coefficient γB. Because the solute obeys Henry’s law as its concentration goes to zero, it follows that aB → xB and γB → 1 as xB → 0 (5.52) at all temperatures and pressures. Deviations of the solute from ideality disappear as zero concentration is approached. Example 5.5 Measuring activity Use the information in Example 5.3 to calculate the activity and activity coefficient of chloroform in acetone at 25°C, treating it first as a solvent and then as a solute. For convenience, the data are repeated here: xC 0 0.20 0.40 0.60 0.80 1 pC/kPa 0 4.7 11 18.9 26.7 36.4 pA/kPa 46.3 33.3 23.3 12.3 4.9 0 Method For the activity of chloroform as a solvent (the Raoult’s law activity), form aC = pC/pC* and γC = aC/xC. For its activity as a solute (the Henry’s law activity), form aC = pC/KC and γC = aC/xC. Answer Because pC* = 36.4 kPa and KC = 22.0 kPa, we can construct the following tables. For instance, at xC = 0.20, in the Raoult’s law case we find aC = (4.7 kPa)/ (36.4 kPa) = 0.13 and γC = 0.13/0.20 = 0.65; likewise, in the Henry’s law case, aC = (4.7 kPa)/(22.0 kPa) = 0.21 and γC = 0.21/0.20 = 1.05. From Raoult’s law (chloroform regarded as the solvent): aC 0 0.13 0.30 0.52 0.73 1.00 γC 0.65 0.75 0.87 0.91 1.00 From Henry’s law (chloroform regarded as the solute): aC 0 0.21 0.50 0.86 1.21 1.65 γC 1 1.05 1.25 1.43 1.51 1.65 These values are plotted in Fig. 5.31. Notice that γC → 1 as xC → 1 in the Raoult’s law case, but that γC → 1 as xC → 0 in the Henry’s law case. Self-test 5.7 Calculate the activities and activity coefficients for acetone according to the two conventions. [At xA = 0.60, for instance aR = 0.50; γR = 0.83; aH = 1.00, γH = 1.67] pB KB 5.7 THE SOLUTE ACTIVITY 161 (c) Activities in terms of molalities The selection of a standard state is entirely arbitrary, so we are free to choose one that best suits our purpose and the description of the composition of the system. In chemistry, compositions are often expressed as molalities, b, in place of mole fractions. It therefore proves convenient to write µB = µB 7 + RT ln bB {5.53}° where µ7 has a different value from the standard values introduced earlier. According to this definition, the chemical potential of the solute has its standard value µ7 when the molality of B is equal to b7 (that is, at 1 mol kg−1 ). Note that as bB → 0, µB → −∞; that is, as the solution becomes diluted, so the solute becomes increasingly stabilized. The practical consequence of this result is that it is very difficult to remove the last traces of a solute from a solution. Now, as before, we incorporate deviations from ideality by introducing a dimensionless activity aB, a dimensionless activity coefficient γB, and writing aB = γB where γB → 1 as bB → 0 [5.54] at all temperatures and pressures. The standard state remains unchanged in this last stage and, as before, all the deviations from ideality are captured in the activity coefficient γB. We then arrive at the following succinct expression for the chemical potential of a real solute at any molality: µ = µ7 + RT ln a (5.55) (d) The biological standard state One important illustration of the ability to choose a standard state to suit the circumstances arises in biological applications. The conventional standard state of hydrogen ions (unit activity, corresponding to pH = 0)5 is not appropriate to normal biological conditions. Therefore, in biochemistry it is common to adopt the biological standard state, in which pH = 7 (an activity of 10−7 , neutral solution) and to label the corresponding standard thermodynamic functions as G⊕ , H⊕ , µ⊕ , and S⊕ (some texts use X7 ′). bB b7 0 0 0 0 0.2 0.2 0.2 0.4 0.4 0.4 0.4 0.6 0.6 0.6 0.8 0.8 0.8 0.8 1 1 1 Mole fraction, x Mole fraction, x Activity,aandactivitycoefficient, 1.2 1.6 2 (a) (b) g Fig. 5.31 The variation of activity and activity coefficient of chloroform (trichloromethane) and acetone (propanone) with composition according to (a) Raoult’s law, (b) Henry’s law. 5 Recall from introductory chemistry courses that pH = –log aH3O+. 162 5 SIMPLE MIXTURES To find the relation between the thermodynamic and biological standard values of the chemical potential of hydrogen ions we need to note from eqn 5.55 that µH+ = µ7 H+ + RT ln aH+ = µ7 H+ − (RT ln 10) × pH It follows that µ⊕ H+ = µ7 H+ − 7RT ln 10 (5.56) At 298 K, 7RT ln 10 = 39.96 kJ mol−1 , so the two standard values differ by about 40 kJ mol−1 . 5.8 The activities of regular solutions The material on regular solutions presented in Section 5.4 gives further insight into the origin of deviations from Raoult’s law and its relation to activity coefficients. The starting point is the expression for the Gibbs energy of mixing for a regular solution (eqn 5.31). We show in the following Justification that eqn 5.31 implies that the activity coefficients are given by expressions of the form ln γA = βxB 2 ln γB = βxA 2 (5.57) These relations are called the Margules equations. Justification 5.4 The Margules equations The Gibbs energy of mixing to form a nonideal solution is ∆mixG = nRT{xA ln aA + xB ln aB} This relation follows from the derivation of eqn 5.31 with activities in place of mole fractions. If each activity is replaced by γx, this expression becomes ∆mixG = nRT{xA ln xA + xB ln xB + xA ln γA + xB ln γB} Now we introduce the two expressions in eqn 5.57, and use xA + xB = 1, which gives ∆mixG = nRT{xA ln xA + xB ln xB + βxAxB 2 + βxBxA 2 } = nRT{xA ln xA + xB ln xB + βxAxB(xA + xB)} = nRT{xA ln xA + xB ln xB + βxAxB} as required by eqn 5.31. Note, moreover, that the activity coefficients behave correctly for dilute solutions: γA → 1 as xB → 0 and γB → 1 as xA → 0. At this point we can use the Margules equations to write the activity of A as aA = γAxA = xAeβxB 2 = xAeβ(1−xA)2 (5.58) with a similar expression for aB. The activity of A, though, is just the ratio of the vapour pressure of A in the solution to the vapour pressure of pure A (eqn 5.43), so we can write pA = {xAeβ(1−xA)2 }pA* (5.59) This function is plotted in Fig. 5.32. We see that β = 0, corresponding to an ideal solution, gives a straight line, in accord with Raoult’s law (indeed, when β = 0, eqn 5.59 becomes pA = xApA*, which is Raoult’s law). Positive values of β (endothermic mixing, unfavourable solute–solvent interactions) give vapour pressures higher than ideal. Negative values of β (exothermic mixing, favourable solute–solvent interactions) give a lower vapour pressure. All the curves approach linearity and coincide with the Raoult’s law line as xA → 1 and the exponential function in eqn 5.59 approaches 1. When xA <<1, eqn 5.59 approaches 0 0.5 1 1.5 0 0.5 1 0 1 1.5 2 2.5 3 ppAA/ xA -1 * Fig. 5.32 The vapour pressure of a mixture based on a model in which the excess enthalpy is proportional to βxAxB. An ideal solution corresponds to β = 0 and gives a straight line, in accord with Raoult’s law. Positive values of β give vapour pressures higher than ideal. Negative values of β give a lower vapour pressure. Exploration Plot pA/pA* against xA with β = 2.5 by using eqn 5.24 and then eqn 5.59. Above what value of xA do the values of pA/pA* given by these equations differ by more than 10 per cent? 5.9 THE ACTIVITIES OF IONS IN SOLUTION 163 pA = xAeβ pA* (5.60) This expression has the form of Henry’s law once we identify K with eβ pA*, which is different for each solute–solvent system. 5.9 The activities of ions in solution Interactions between ions are so strong that the approximation of replacing activities by molalities is valid only in very dilute solutions (less than 10−3 mol kg−1 in total ion concentration) and in precise work activities themselves must be used. We need, therefore, to pay special attention to the activities of ions in solution, especially in preparation for the discussion of electrochemical phenomena. (a) Mean activity coefficients If the chemical potential of a univalent cation M+ is denoted µ+ and that of a univalent anion X− is denoted µ−, the total molar Gibbs energy of the ions in the electrically neutral solution is the sum of these partial molar quantities. The molar Gibbs energy of an ideal solution is Gm ideal = µ+ ideal + µ− ideal (5.61)° However, for a real solution of M+ and X− of the same molality, Gm = µ+ + µ− = µ+ ideal + µ− ideal + RT ln γ+ + RT ln γ− = Gm ideal + RT ln γ+γ− (5.62) All the deviations from ideality are contained in the last term. There is no experimental way of separating the product γ+γ− into contributions from the cations and the anions. The best we can do experimentally is to assign responsibility for the nonideality equally to both kinds of ion. Therefore, for a 1,1electrolyte, we introduce the mean activity coefficient as the geometric mean of the individual coefficients: γ± = (γ+γ−)1/2 [5.63] and express the individual chemical potentials of the ions as µ+ = µ+ ideal + RT lnγ± µ− = µ− ideal + RT ln γ± (5.64) The sum of these two chemical potentials is the same as before, eqn 5.62, but now the nonideality is shared equally. We can generalize this approach to the case of a compound MpXq that dissolves to give a solution of p cations and q anions from each formula unit. The molar Gibbs energy of the ions is the sum of their partial molar Gibbs energies: Gm = pµ+ + qµ− = Gm ideal + pRT lnγ+ + qRT lnγ− (5.65) If we introduce the mean activity coefficient γ± = (γ+ p γ − q )1/s s = p + q [5.66] and write the chemical potential of each ion as µi = µi ideal + RT lnγ± (5.67) we get the same expression as in eqn 5.62 for Gm when we write G = pµ+ + qµ− (5.68) However, both types of ion now share equal responsibility for the nonideality. (b) The Debye–Hückel limiting law The long range and strength of the Coulombic interaction between ions means that it is likely to be primarily responsible for the departures from ideality in ionic solutions Comment 5.4 The geometric mean of xp and yq is (xp yq )1/(p+q) . For example, the geometric mean of x2 and y−3 is (x2 y−3 )−1 . 164 5 SIMPLE MIXTURES Fig. 5.33 The picture underlying the Debye–Hückel theory is of a tendency for anions to be found around cations, and of cations to be found around anions (one such local clustering region is shown by the circle). The ions are in ceaseless motion, and the diagram represents a snapshot of their motion. The solutions to which the theory applies are far less concentrated than shown here. Table 5.4 Ionic strength and molality, I = kb/b7 k X− X2− X3− X4− M+ 1 3 6 10 M2+ 3 4 15 12 M3+ 6 15 9 42 M4+ 10 12 42 16 For example, the ionic strength of an M2X3 solution of molality b, which is understood to give M3+ and X2− ions in solution is 15b/b7 . and to dominate all the other contributions to nonideality. This domination is the basis of the Debye–Hückel theory of ionic solutions, which was devised by Peter Debye and Erich Hückel in 1923. We give here a qualitative account of the theory and its principal conclusions. The calculation itself, which is a profound example of how a seemingly intractable problem can be formulated and then resolved by drawing on physical insight, is described in Further information 5.1. Oppositely charged ions attract one another. As a result, anions are more likely to be found near cations in solution, and vice versa (Fig. 5.33). Overall, the solution is electrically neutral, but near any given ion there is an excess of counter ions (ions of opposite charge). Averaged over time, counter ions are more likely to be found near any given ion. This time-averaged, spherical haze around the central ion, in which counter ions outnumber ions of the same charge as the central ion, has a net charge equal in magnitude but opposite in sign to that on the central ion, and is called its ionicatmosphere. The energy, and therefore the chemical potential, of any given central ion is lowered as a result of its electrostatic interaction with its ionic atmosphere. This lowering of energy appears as the difference between the molar Gibbs energy Gm and the ideal value Gm ideal of the solute, and hence can be identified with RT ln γ±. The stabilization of ions by their interaction with their ionic atmospheres is part of the explanation why chemists commonly use dilute solutions, in which the stabilization is less important, to achieve precipitation of ions from electrolyte solutions. The model leads to the result that at very low concentrations the activity coefficient can be calculated from the Debye–Hückel limiting law log γ± = −|z+z− |AI1/2 (5.69) where A = 0.509 for an aqueous solution at 25°C and I is the dimensionless ionic strength of the solution: I = 1 –2 ∑ i zi 2 (bi/b7 ) [5.70] In this expression zi is the charge number of an ion i (positive for cations and negative for anions) and bi is its molality. The ionic strength occurs widely wherever ionic solutions are discussed, as we shall see. The sum extends over all the ions present in the solution. For solutions consisting of two types of ion at molalities b+ and b−, I = 1 –2(b+z+ 2 + b−z− 2 )/b7 (5.71) The ionic strength emphasizes the charges of the ions because the charge numbers occur as their squares. Table 5.4 summarizes the relation of ionic strength and molality in an easily usable form. Illustration 5.4 Using the Debye–Hückel limiting law The mean activity coefficient of 5.0 × 10−3 mol kg−1 KCl(aq) at 25°C is calculated by writing I = 1 –2(b+ + b−)/b7 = b/b7 where b is the molality of the solution (and b+ = b− = b). Then, from eqn 5.69, log γ± = −0.509 × (5.0 × 10−3 )1/2 = −0.036 Hence, γ± = 0.92. The experimental value is 0.927. Self-test 5.8 Calculate the ionic strength and the mean activity coefficient of 1.00 mmol kg−1 CaCl2(aq) at 25°C. [3.00 mmol kg−1 , 0.880] 5.9 THE ACTIVITIES OF IONS IN SOLUTION 165 The name ‘limiting law’ is applied to eqn 5.69 because ionic solutions of moderate molalities may have activity coefficients that differ from the values given by this expression, yet all solutions are expected to conform as b → 0. Table 5.5 lists some experimental values of activity coefficients for salts of various valence types. Figure 5.34 shows some of these values plotted against I1/2 , and compares them with the theoretical straight lines calculated from eqn 5.69. The agreement at very low molalities (less than about 1 mmol kg−1 , depending on charge type) is impressive, and convincing evidence in support of the model. Nevertheless, the departures from the theoretical curves above these molalities are large, and show that the approximations are valid only at very low concentrations. (c) The extended Debye–Hückel law When the ionic strength of the solution is too high for the limiting law to be valid, the activity coefficient may be estimated from the extended Debye–Hückel law: log γ± = − + CI (5.72) where B and C are dimensionless constants. Although B can be interpreted as a measure of the closest approach of the ions, it (like C) is best regarded as an adjustable empirical parameter. A curve drawn in this way is shown in Fig. 5.35. It is clear that A|z+z− |I1/2 1 + BI1/2 Synoptic Table 5.5* Mean activity coefficients in water at 298 K b/b7 KCl CaCl2 0.001 0.966 0.888 0.01 0.902 0.732 0.1 0.770 0.524 1.0 0.607 0.725 * More values are given in the Data section. 4 8 12 0 -0.1 -0.2 log± NaCl (1,1) MgCl2 (1,2) MgSO4 (2,2) 100I1/2 0 16 g Fig. 5.34 An experimental test of the Debye–Hückel limiting law. Although there are marked deviations for moderate ionic strengths, the limiting slopes as I → 0 are in good agreement with the theory, so the law can be used for extrapolating data to very low molalities. 0 -0.02 -0.04 -0.06 -0.08 0 4 8 12 16 Extended law Limiting law log± 100I1/2 g Fig. 5.35 The extended Debye–Hückel law gives agreement with experiment over a wider range of molalities (as shown here for a 1,1-electrolyte), but it fails at higher molalities. Exploration Consider the plot of log γ± against I1/2 with B = 1.50 and C = 0 as a representation of experimental data for a certain 1,1-electrolyte. Over what range of ionic strengths does the application of the limiting law lead to an error in the value of the activity coefficient of less than 10 per cent of the value predicted by the extended law? 166 5 SIMPLE MIXTURES Checklist of key ideas 1. The partial molar volume is the change in volume per mole of A added to a large volume of the mixture: VJ = (∂V/∂nJ)p,T,n′. The total volume of a mixture is V = nAVA + nBVB. 2. The chemical potential can be defined in terms of the partial molar Gibbs energy, µJ = (∂G/∂nJ)p,T,n′. The total Gibbs energy of a mixture is G = nAµA + nBµB. 3. The fundamental equation of chemical thermodynamics relates the change in Gibbs energy to changes in pressure, temperature, and composition: dG = Vdp − SdT + µAdnA + µBdnB + · · ·. 4. The Gibbs–Duhem equation is ∑JnJdµJ = 0. 5. The chemical potential of a perfect gas is µ = µ7 + RT ln(p/p7 ), where µ7 is the standard chemical potential, the chemical potential of the pure gas at 1 bar. 6. The Gibbs energy of mixing of two perfect gases is given by ∆mixG = nRT(xA ln xA + xB ln xB). 7. The entropy of mixing of two perfect gases is given by ∆mixS = –nR(xA ln xA + xB ln xB). 8. The enthalpy of mixing is ∆mixH = 0 for perfect gases. 9. An ideal solution is a solution in which all components obeys Raoult’s law (pA = xApA*) throughout the composition range. 10. The chemical potential of a component of an ideal solution is given by µA = µA* + RT ln xA. 11. An ideal-dilute solution is a solution for which the solute obeys Henry’s law (pB = xBKB*) and the solvent obeys Raoult’s law. 12. The Gibbs energy of mixing of two liquids that form an ideal solution is given by ∆mixG = nRT(xA ln xA + xB ln xB). 13. The entropy of mixing of two liquids that form an ideal solution is given by ∆mixS = –nR(xA ln xA + xB ln xB). 14. An excess function (XE ) is the difference between the observed thermodynamic function of mixing and the function for an ideal solution. 15. A regular solution is a solution for which HE ≠ 0 but SE = 0. 16. A colligative property is a property that depends only on the number of solute particles present, not their identity. 17. The elevation of boiling point is given by ∆T = Kbb, where Kb is the ebullioscopic constant. The depression of freezing point is given by ∆T = Kfb, where Kf is the cryoscopic constant. 18. Osmosis is the spontaneous passage of a pure solvent into a solution separated from it by a semipermeable membrane, a membrane permeable to the solvent but not to the solute. 19. The osmotic pressure is the pressure that must be applied to the solution to stop the influx of solvent. 20. The van ’t Hoff equation for the osmotic pressure is Π = [B]RT. 21. The activity is defined as aA = pA/pA*. 22. The solvent activity is related to its chemical potential by µA = µA* + RT ln aA. The activity may be written in terms of the activity coefficient γA = aA/xA. 23. The chemical potential of a solute in an ideal-dilute solution is given by µB = µB 7 + RT ln aB. The activity may be written in terms of the activity coefficient γB = aB/xB. 24. The biological standard state (pH = 7) is related to the thermodynamic standard state by µ⊕ H+ = µ7 H+ – 7RT ln 10. 25. The mean activity coefficient is the geometric mean of the individual coefficients: γ± = (γ+ p γ− q )1/(p + q) . 26. The Debye–Hückel theory of activity coefficients of electrolyte solutions is based on the assumption that Coulombic interactions between ions are dominant; a key idea of the theory is that of an ionic atmosphere. 27. The Debye–Hückel limiting law is log γ± = −|z+z− |AI1/2 where I is the ionic strength, I = 1 –2 ∑iz2 i(bi/b7 ). 28. The extended Debye–Hückel law is ln γ± = −|z+z− |AI1/2 /(1 + BI1/2 ) + CI. eqn 5.72 accounts for some activity coefficients over a moderate range of dilute solutions (up to about 0.1 mol kg−1 ); nevertheless it remains very poor near 1 mol kg−1 . Current theories of activity coefficients for ionic solutes take an indirect route. They set up a theory for the dependence of the activity coefficient of the solvent on the concentration of the solute, and then use the Gibbs–Duhem equation (eqn 5.12) to estimate the activity coefficient of the solute. The results are reasonably reliable for solutions with molalities greater than about 0.1 mol kg−1 and are valuable for the discussion of mixed salt solutions, such as sea water. FURTHER INFORMATION 167 Further reading Articles and texts6 B. Freeman, Osmosis. In Encyclopedia of applied physics (ed. G.L. Trigg), 13, 59. VCH, New York (1995). J.N. Murrell and A.D. Jenkins, Properties of liquids and solutions. Wiley–Interscience, New York (1994). J.S. Rowlinson and F.L. Swinton, Liquids and liquid mixtures. Butterworths, London (1982). S. Sattar, Thermodynamics of mixing real gases. J. Chem. Educ. 77, 1361 (2000). Sources of data and information M.R.J. Dack, Solutions and solubilities. In Techniques of chemistry (ed. A. Weissberger and B.W. Rossiter), 8. Wiley, New York (1975). R.C. Weast (ed.), Handbook of chemistry and physics, Vol. 81. CRC Press, Boca Raton (2004). 6 See Further reading in Chapter 2 for additional texts on chemical thermodynamics. 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 0 Potential,/(/)ZrD 0 0.5 1 Distance, r/rD 0.3 1 3 ¥ f Fig. 5.36 The variation of the shielded Coulomb potential with distance for different values of the Debye length, rD/a. The smaller the Debye length, the more sharply the potential decays to zero. In each case, a is an arbitrary unit of length. Exploration Write an expression for the difference between the unshielded and shielded Coulomb potentials evaluated at rD. Then plot this expression against rD and provide a physical interpretation for the shape of the plot. Further information Further information 5.1 The Debye–Hückel theory of ionic solutions Imagine a solution in which all the ions have their actual positions, but in which their Coulombic interactions have been turned off. The difference in molar Gibbs energy between the ideal and real solutions is equal to we, the electrical work of charging the system in this arrangement. For a salt MpXq, we write Gm Gm ideal we = (pµ+ + qµ−) − (pµ+ ideal + qµ− ideal ) = p(µ+ − µ+ ideal ) + q(µ− − µ− ideal ) From eqn 5.64 we write µ+ − µ+ ideal = µ− − µ− ideal = RT ln γ± So it follows that ln γ± = s = p + q (5.73) This equation tells us that we must first find the final distribution of the ions and then the work of charging them in that distribution. The Coulomb potential at a distance r from an isolated ion of charge zie in a medium of permittivity ε is φi = Zi = (5.74) The ionic atmosphere causes the potential to decay with distance more sharply than this expression implies. Such shielding is a familiar problem in electrostatics, and its effect is taken into account by replacing the Coulomb potential by the shielded Coulomb potential, an expression of the form φi = e−r/rD (5.75) Zi r zte 4πε Zi r we sRT 5 4 4 6 4 4 7 5 4 6 4 7 where rD is called the Debye length. When rD is large, the shielded potential is virtually the same as the unshielded potential. When it is small, the shielded potential is much smaller than the unshielded potential, even for short distances (Fig. 5.36). 168 5 SIMPLE MIXTURES To calculate rD, we need to know how the charge density, ρi, of the ionic atmosphere, the charge in a small region divided by the volume of the region, varies with distance from the ion. This step draws on another standard result of electrostatics, in which charge density and potential are related by Poisson’s equation (see Appendix 3): ∇2 φ = − (5.76) where ∇2 = (∂2 /∂x2 + ∂2 /∂y2 + ∂2 /∂z2 ) is called the laplacian. Because we are considering only a spherical ionic atmosphere, we can use a simplified form of this equation in which the charge density varies only with distance from the central ion: r2 = − Comment 5.5 For systems with spherical symmetry, it is best to work in spherical polar coordinates r, θ, and φ (see the illustration): x = r sin θ cos φ, y = r sin θ sin φ, and z = r cos θ. The laplacian in spherical polar coordinates is ∇2 = r2 + sinθ + When a function depends only on r, the derivatives in the second and third terms evaluate to zero and the laplacian takes the form ∇2 = r2 Substitution of the expression for the shielded potential, eqn 5.75, results in r2 D = − (5.77) To solve this equation we need to relate ρi and φi. For the next step we draw on the fact that the energy of an ion depends on its closeness to the central ion, and then use the Boltzmann distribution (see Section 16.1) to work out the probability that an ion will be found at each distance. The energy of an ion of charge zje at a distance where it experiences the potential φi of the central ion i relative to its energy when it is far away in the bulk solution is its charge times the potential: E = zjeφi εφi ρi D E F d dr A B C d dr 1 r2 z x y r q f ∂2 ∂θ2 1 r2 sin2 θ D E F ∂ ∂θ A B C ∂ ∂θ 1 r2 sinθ D E F ∂ ∂r A B C ∂ ∂r 1 r2 ρi ε D E F dφi dr A B C d dr 1 r2 ρ ε Therefore, according to the Boltzmann distribution, the ratio of the molar concentration, cj, of ions at a distance r and the molar concentration in the bulk, cj°, where the energy is zero, is: = e−E/kT The charge density, ρi, at a distance r from the ion i is the molar concentration of each type of ion multiplied by the charge per mole of ions, zieNA. The quantity eNA, the magnitude of the charge per mole of electrons, is Faraday’s constant, F = 96.48 kC mol−1 . It follows that ρi = c+z+F + c−z−F = c+°z+Fe−z+eφi/kT + c−°z−Fe−z−eφi/kT (5.78) At this stage we need to simplify the expression to avoid the awkward exponential terms. Because the average electrostatic interaction energy is small compared with kT we may write eqn 5.78 as ρi = c+°z+F 1 − + · · · + c−°z−F 1 − + · · · = (c+°z+ + c−°z−)F − (c+°z+ 2 + c−°z− 2 )F + · · · Comment 5.6 The expansion of an exponential function used here is e−x = 1 − x + 1–2x2 − · · · . If x << 1, then e−x ≈ 1 − x. Replacing e by F/NA and NAk by R results in the following expression: ρi = (c+°z+ + c−°z−)F − (c+°z+ 2 + c−°z− 2 ) + · · · (5.79) The first term in the expansion is zero because it is the charge density in the bulk, uniform solution, and the solution is electrically neutral. The unwritten terms are assumed to be too small to be significant. The one remaining term can be expressed in terms of the ionic strength, eqn 5.70, by noting that in the dilute aqueous solutions we are considering there is little difference between molality and molar concentration, and c ≈ bρ, where ρ is the mass density of the solvent c+°z+ 2 + c−°z− 2 ≈ (b+°z+ 2 + b−°z− 2 )ρ = 2Ib7 ρ With these approximations, eqn 5.78 becomes ρi = − We can now solve eqn 5.77 for rD: rD = 1/2 (5.80) To calculate the activity coefficient we need to find the electrical work of charging the central ion when it is surrounded by its atmosphere. To do so, we need to know the potential at the ion due to its atmosphere, φatmos. This potential is the difference between the total potential, given by eqn 5.75, and the potential due to the central ion itself: φatmos = φ − φcentral ion = Zi − The potential at the central ion (at r = 0) is obtained by taking the limit of this expression as r → 0 and is φatmos(0) = Zi rD D E F 1 r e−r/rD r A B C D E F εRT 2ρF2 Ib7 A B C 2ρF2 Ib7 φi RT F2 φi RT eφi kT D E F z−eφi kT A B C D E F z+eφi kT A B C cj cj° EXERCISES 169 This expression shows us that the potential of the ionic atmosphere is equivalent to the potential arising from a single charge of equal magnitude but opposite sign to that of the central ion and located at a distance rD from the ion. If the charge of the central ion were q and not zie, then the potential due to its atmosphere would be φatmos(0) = − The work of adding a charge dq to a region where the electrical potential is φatmos(0) is dwe = φatmos(0)dq Therefore, the total molar work of fully charging the ions is we = NAΎ0 zie φatmos(0) dq = − Ύ0 zie q dq = − = − where in the last step we have used F = NAe. It follows from eqn 5.73 that the mean activity coefficient of the ions is ln γ± = = − However, for neutrality pz+ + qz− = 0; therefore (pz2 + + qz2 −)F2 8πεsNARTrD pwe,+ + qwe,− sRT zi 2 F2 8πεNArD NAzi 2 e2 8πεrD NA 4πεrD q 4πεrD Comment 5.7 For this step, multiply pz+ + qz− = 0 by p and also, separately, by q; add the two expressions and rearrange the result by using p + q = s and z+z− = −|z+z− |. ln γ± = − Replacing rD with the expression in eqn 5.79 gives ln γ± = − 1/2 = −|z+z− | 1/2 I1/2 where we have grouped terms in such a way as to show that this expression is beginning to take the form of eqn 5.69. Indeed, conversion to common logarithms (by using ln x = ln 10 × log x) gives log γ± = −|z+z− | 1/2 I1/2 which is eqn 5.69 (log γ± = −|z+z− |AI1/2 ) with A = 1/2 (5.81) D E F ρb7 2ε3 R3 T3 A B C F3 4πNA ln 10 5 6 7 D E F ρb7 2ε3 R3 T3 A B C F3 4πNA ln 10 1 2 3 5 6 7 D E F ρb7 2ε3 R3 T3 A B C F3 4πNA 1 2 3 D E F 2ρF2 Ib7 εRT A B C |z+z− |F2 8πεNART |z+z− |F2 8πεNARTrD Discussion questions 5.1 State and justify the thermodynamic criterion for solution–vapour equilibrium. 5.2 How is Raoult’s law modified so as to describe the vapour pressure of real solutions? 5.3 Explain how colligative properties are used to determine molar mass. 5.4 Explain the origin of colligative properties. 5.5 Explain what is meant by a regular solution. 5.6 Describe the general features of the Debye–Hückel theory of electrolyte solutions. Exercises 5.1(a) The partial molar volumes of acetone (propanone) and chloroform (trichloromethane) in a mixture in which the mole fraction of CHCl3 is 0.4693 are 74.166 cm3 mol−1 and 80.235 cm3 mol−1 , respectively. What is the volume of a solution of mass 1.000 kg? 5.1(b) The partial molar volumes of two liquids A and B in a mixture in which the mole fraction of A is 0.3713 are 188.2 cm3 mol−1 and 176.14 cm3 mol−1 , respectively. The molar masses of A and B are 241.1 g mol−1 and 198.2 g mol−1 . What is the volume of a solution of mass 1.000 kg? 5.2(a) At 25°C, the density of a 50 per cent by mass ethanol–water solution is 0.914 g cm−3 . Given that the partial molar volume of water in the solution is 17.4 cm3 mol−1 , calculate the partial molar volume of the ethanol. 5.2(b) At 20°C, the density of a 20 per cent by mass ethanol–water solution is 968.7 kg m−3 . Given that the partial molar volume of ethanol in the solution is 52.2 cm3 mol−1 , calculate the partial molar volume of the water. 5.3(a) At 300 K, the partial vapour pressures of HCl (that is, the partial pressure of the HCl vapour) in liquid GeCl4 are as follows: xHCl 0.005 0.012 0.019 pHCl/kPa 32.0 76.9 121.8 Show that the solution obeys Henry’s law in this range of mole fractions, and calculate Henry’s law constant at 300 K. 5.3(b) At 310 K, the partial vapour pressures of a substance B dissolved in a liquid A are as follows: xB 0.010 0.015 0.020 pB/kPa 82.0 122.0 166.1 Show that the solution obeys Henry’s law in this range of mole fractions, and calculate Henry’s law constant at 310 K. 170 5 SIMPLE MIXTURES 5.4(a) Predict the partial vapour pressure of HCl above its solution in liquid germanium tetrachloride of molality 0.10 mol kg−1 . For data, see Exercise 5.3a. 5.4(b) Predict the partial vapour pressure of the component B above its solution in A in Exercise 5.3b when the molality of B is 0.25 mol kg−1 . The molar mass of A is 74.1 g mol−1 . 5.5(a) The vapour pressure of benzene is 53.3 kPa at 60.6°C, but it fell to 51.5 kPa when 19.0 g of an involatile organic compound was dissolved in 500 g of benzene. Calculate the molar mass of the compound. 5.5(b) The vapour pressure of 2-propanol is 50.00 kPa at 338.8°C, but it fell to 49.62 kPa when 8.69 g of an involatile organic compound was dissolved in 250 g of 2-propanol. Calculate the molar mass of the compound. 5.6(a) The addition of 100 g of a compound to 750 g of CCl4 lowered the freezing point of the solvent by 10.5 K. Calculate the molar mass of the compound. 5.6(b) The addition of 5.00 g of a compound to 250 g of naphthalene lowered the freezing point of the solvent by 0.780 K. Calculate the molar mass of the compound. 5.7(a) The osmotic pressure of an aqueous solution at 300 K is 120 kPa. Calculate the freezing point of the solution. 5.7(b) The osmotic pressure of an aqueous solution at 288 K is 99.0 kPa. Calculate the freezing point of the solution. 5.8(a) Consider a container of volume 5.0 dm3 that is divided into two compartments of equal size. In the left compartment there is nitrogen at 1.0 atm and 25°C; in the right compartment there is hydrogen at the same temperature and pressure. Calculate the entropy and Gibbs energy of mixing when the partition is removed. Assume that the gases are perfect. 5.8(b) Consider a container of volume 250 cm3 that is divided into two compartments of equal size. In the left compartment there is argon at 100 kPa and 0°C; in the right compartment there is neon at the same temperature and pressure. Calculate the entropy and Gibbs energy of mixing when the partition is removed. Assume that the gases are perfect. 5.9(a) Air is a mixture with a composition given in Self-test 1.4. Calculate the entropy of mixing when it is prepared from the pure (and perfect) gases. 5.9(b) Calculate the Gibbs energy, entropy, and enthalpy of mixing when 1.00 mol C6H14 (hexane) is mixed with 1.00 mol C7H16 (heptane) at 298 K; treat the solution as ideal. 5.10(a) What proportions of hexane and heptane should be mixed (a) by mole fraction, (b) by mass in order to achieve the greatest entropy of mixing? 5.10(b) What proportions of benzene and ethylbenzene should be mixed (a) by mole fraction, (b) by mass in order to achieve the greatest entropy of mixing? 5.11(a) Use Henry’s law and the data in Table 5.1 to calculate the solubility (as a molality) of CO2 in water at 25°C when its partial pressure is (a) 0.10 atm, (b) 1.00 atm. 5.11(b) The mole fractions of N2 and O2 in air at sea level are approximately 0.78 and 0.21. Calculate the molalities of the solution formed in an open flask of water at 25°C. 5.12(a) A water carbonating plant is available for use in the home and operates by providing carbon dioxide at 5.0 atm. Estimate the molar concentration of the soda water it produces. 5.12(b) After some weeks of use, the pressure in the water carbonating plant mentioned in the previous exercise has fallen to 2.0 atm. Estimate the molar concentration of the soda water it produces at this stage. 5.13(a) The enthalpy of fusion of anthracene is 28.8 kJ mol−1 and its melting point is 217°C. Calculate its ideal solubility in benzene at 25°C. 5.13(b) Predict the ideal solubility of lead in bismuth at 280°C given that its melting point is 327°C and its enthalpy of fusion is 5.2 kJ mol−1 . 5.14(a) The osmotic pressure of solutions of polystyrene in toluene were measured at 25°C and the pressure was expressed in terms of the height of the solvent of density 1.004 g cm−3 : c/(g dm−3 ) 2.042 6.613 9.521 12.602 h/cm 0.592 1.910 2.750 3.600 Calculate the molar mass of the polymer. 5.14(b) The molar mass of an enzyme was determined by dissolving it in water, measuring the osmotic pressure at 20°C, and extrapolating the data to zero concentration. The following data were obtained: c/(mg cm−3 ) 3.221 4.618 5.112 6.722 h/cm 5.746 8.238 9.119 11.990 Calculate the molar mass of the enzyme. 5.15(a) Substances A and B are both volatile liquids with pA* = 300 Torr, pB* = 250 Torr, and KB = 200 Torr (concentration expressed in mole fraction). When xA = 0.9, bB = 2.22 mol kg−1 , pA = 250 Torr, and pB = 25 Torr. Calculate the activities and activity coefficients of A and B. Use the mole fraction, Raoult’s law basis system for A and the Henry’s law basis system (both mole fractions and molalities ) for B. 5.15(b) Given that p*(H2O) = 0.02308 atm and p(H2O) = 0.02239 atm in a solution in which 0.122 kg of a non-volatile solute (M = 241 g mol−1 ) is dissolved in 0.920 kg water at 293 K, calculate the activity and activity coefficient of water in the solution. 5.16(a) A dilute solution of bromine in carbon tetrachloride behaves as an ideal-dilute solution. The vapour pressure of pure CCl4 is 33.85 Torr at 298 K. The Henry’s law constant when the concentration of Br2 is expressed as a mole fraction is 122.36 Torr. Calculate the vapour pressure of each component, the total pressure, and the composition of the vapour phase when the mole fraction of Br2 is 0.050, on the assumption that the conditions of the idealdilute solution are satisfied at this concentration. 5.16(b) Benzene and toluene form nearly ideal solutions. The boiling point of pure benzene is 80.1°C. Calculate the chemical potential of benzene relative to that of pure benzene when xbenzene = 0.30 at its boiling point. If the activity coefficient of benzene in this solution were actually 0.93 rather than 1.00, what would be its vapour pressure? 5.17(a) By measuring the equilibrium between liquid and vapour phases of an acetone (A)–methanol (M) solution at 57.2°C at 1.00 atm, it was found that xA = 0.400 when yA = 0.516. Calculate the activities and activity coefficients of both components in this solution on the Raoult’s law basis. The vapour pressures of the pure components at this temperature are: pA* = 105 kPa and p*M = 73.5 kPa. (xA is the mole fraction in the liquid and yA the mole fraction in the vapour.) 5.17(b) By measuring the equilibrium between liquid and vapour phases of a solution at 30°C at 1.00 atm, it was found that xA = 0.220 when yA = 0.314. Calculate the activities and activity coefficients of both components in this solution on the Raoult’s law basis. The vapour pressures of the pure components at this temperature are: pA* = 73.0 kPa and pB* = 92.1 kPa. (xA is the mole fraction in the liquid and yA the mole fraction in the vapour.) 5.18(a) Calculate the ionic strength of a solution that is 0.10 mol kg−1 in KCl(aq) and 0.20 mol kg−1 in CuSO4(aq). 5.18(b) Calculate the ionic strength of a solution that is 0.040 mol kg−1 in K3[Fe(CN)6](aq), 0.030 mol kg−1 in KCl(aq), and 0.050 mol kg−1 in NaBr(aq). PROBLEMS 171 5.19(a) Calculate the masses of (a) Ca(NO3)2 and, separately, (b) NaCl to add to a 0.150 mol kg−1 solution of KNO3(aq) containing 500 g of solvent to raise its ionic strength to 0.250. 5.19(b) Calculate the masses of (a) KNO3 and, separately, (b) Ba(NO3)2 to add to a 0.110 mol kg−1 solution of KNO3(aq) containing 500 g of solvent to raise its ionic strength to 1.00. 5.20(a) Estimate the mean ionic activity coefficient and activity of a solution that is 0.010 mol kg−1 CaCl2(aq) and 0.030 mol kg−1 NaF(aq). 5.20(b) Estimate the mean ionic activity coefficient and activity of a solution that is 0.020 mol kg−1 NaCl(aq) and 0.035 mol kg−1 Ca(NO3)2(aq). 5.21(a) The mean activity coefficients of HBr in three dilute aqueous solutions at 25°C are 0.930 (at 5.0 mmol kg−1 ), 0.907 (at 10.0 mmol kg−1 ), and 0.879 (at 20.0 mmol kg−1 ). Estimate the value of B in the extended Debye–Hückel law. 5.21(b) The mean activity coefficients of KCl in three dilute aqueous solutions at 25°C are 0.927 (at 5.0 mmol kg−1 ), 0.902 (at 10.0 mmol kg−1 ), and 0.816 (at 50.0 mmol kg−1 ). Estimate the value of B in the extended Debye–Hückel law. Problems* Numerical problems 5.1 The following table gives the mole fraction of methylbenzene (A) in liquid and gaseous mixtures with butanone at equilibrium at 303.15 K and the total pressure p. Take the vapour to be perfect and calculate the partial pressures of the two components. Plot them against their respective mole fractions in the liquid mixture and find the Henry’s law constants for the two components. xA 0 0.0898 0.2476 0.3577 0.5194 0.6036 yA 0 0.0410 0.1154 0.1762 0.2772 0.3393 p/kPa 36.066 34.121 30.900 28.626 25.239 23.402 xA 0.7188 0.8019 0.9105 1 yA 0.4450 0.5435 0.7284 1 p/kPa 20.6984 18.592 15.496 12.295 5.2 The volume of an aqueous solution of NaCl at 25°C was measured at a series of molalities b, and it was found that the volume fitted the expression v = 1003 + 16.62x + 1.77x3/2 + 0.12x2 where v = V/cm3 , V is the volume of a solution formed from 1.000 kg of water, and x = b/b7 . Calculate the partial molar volume of the components in a solution of molality 0.100 mol kg−1 . 5.3 At 18°C the total volume V of a solution formed from MgSO4 and 1.000 kg of water fits the expression v = 1001.21 + 34.69(x − 0.070)2 , where v = V/cm3 and x = b/b7 . Calculate the partial molar volumes of the salt and the solvent when in a solution of molality 0.050 mol kg−1 . 5.4 The densities of aqueous solutions of copper(II) sulfate at 20°C were measured as set out below. Determine and plot the partial molar volume of CuSO4 in the range of the measurements. m(CuSO4)/g 5 10 15 20 ρ/(g cm−3 ) 1.051 1.107 1.167 1.230 where m(CuSO4) is the mass of CuSO4 dissolved in 100 g of solution. 5.5 What proportions of ethanol and water should be mixed in order to produce 100 cm3 of a mixture containing 50 per cent by mass of ethanol? What change in volume is brought about by adding 1.00 cm3 of ethanol to the mixture? (Use data from Fig. 5.1.) 5.6 Potassium fluoride is very soluble in glacial acetic acid and the solutions have a number of unusual properties. In an attempt to understand them, freezing point depression data were obtained by taking a solution of known molality and then diluting it several times (J. Emsley, J. Chem. Soc. A, 2702 (1971)). The following data were obtained: b/(mol kg−1 ) 0.015 0.037 0.077 0.295 0.602 ∆T/K 0.115 0.295 0.470 1.381 2.67 Calculate the apparent molar mass of the solute and suggest an interpretation. Use ∆fusH = 11.4 kJ mol−1 and Tf* = 290 K. 5.7 In a study of the properties of an aqueous solution of Th(NO3)4 (by A. Apelblat, D. Azoulay, and A. Sahar, J. Chem. Soc. Faraday Trans., I, 1618, (1973)), a freezing point depression of 0.0703 K was observed for an aqueous solution of molality 9.6 mmol kg−1 . What is the apparent number of ions per formula unit? 5.8 The table below lists the vapour pressures of mixtures of iodoethane (I) and ethyl acetate (A) at 50°C. Find the activity coefficients of both components on (a) the Raoult’s law basis, (b) the Henry’s law basis with iodoethane as solute. xI 0 0.0579 0.1095 0.1918 0.2353 0.3718 pI/kPa 0 3.73 7.03 11.7 14.05 20.72 pA/kPa 37.38 35.48 33.64 30.85 29.44 25.05 xI 0.5478 0.6349 0.8253 0.9093 1.0000 pI/kPa 28.44 31.88 39.58 43.00 47.12 pA/kPa 19.23 16.39 8.88 5.09 0 5.9 Plot the vapour pressure data for a mixture of benzene (B) and acetic acid (A) given below and plot the vapour pressure/composition curve for the mixture at 50°C. Then confirm that Raoult’s and Henry’s laws are obeyed in the appropriate regions. Deduce the activities and activity coefficients of the components on the Raoult’s law basis and then, taking B as the solute, its activity and activity coefficient on a Henry’s law basis. Finally, evaluate the excess Gibbs energy of the mixture over the composition range spanned by the data. xA 0.0160 0.0439 0.0835 0.1138 0.1714 pA/kPa 0.484 0.967 1.535 1.89 2.45 pB/kPa 35.05 34.29 33.28 32.64 30.90 xA 0.2973 0.3696 0.5834 0.6604 0.8437 0.9931 pA/kPa 3.31 3.83 4.84 5.36 6.76 7.29 pB/kPa 28.16 26.08 20.42 18.01 10.0 0.47 5.10‡ Aminabhavi et al. examined mixtures of cyclohexane with various longchain alkanes (T.M. Aminabhavi, V.B. Patil, M.I, Aralaguppi, J.D. Ortego, and K.C. Hansen, J. Chem. Eng. Data 41, 526 (1996)). Among their data are the following measurements of the density of a mixture of cyclohexane and pentadecane as a function of mole fraction of cyclohexane (xc) at 298.15 K: xc 0.6965 0.7988 0.9004 ρ/(g cm−3 ) 0.7661 0.7674 0.7697 * Problems denoted with the symbol ‡ were supplied by Charles Trapp, Carmen Giunta, and Marshall Cady. 172 5 SIMPLE MIXTURES Compute the partial molar volume for each component in a mixture that has a mole fraction cyclohexane of 0.7988. 5.11‡ Comelli and Francesconi examined mixtures of propionic acid with various other organic liquids at 313.15 K (F. Comelli and R. Francesconi, J. Chem. Eng. Data 41, 101 (1996)). They report the excess volume of mixing propionic acid with oxane as VE = x1x2{a0 + a1(x1 − x2)}, where x1 is the mole fraction of propionic acid, x2 that of oxane, a0 = −2.4697 cm3 mol−1 and a1 = 0.0608 cm3 mol−1 . The density of propionic acid at this temperature is 0.97174 g cm−3 ; that of oxane is 0.86398 g cm−3 . (a) Derive an expression for the partial molar volume of each component at this temperature. (b) Compute the partial molar volume for each component in an equimolar mixture. 5.12‡ Francesconi et al. studied the liquid–vapour equilibria of trichloromethane and 1,2-epoxybutane at several temperatures (R. Francesconi, B. Lunelli, and F. Comelli, J. Chem. Eng. Data 41, 310 (1996)). Among their data are the following measurements of the mole fractions of trichloromethane in the liquid phase (xT) and the vapour phase (yT) at 298.15 K as a function of pressure. p/kPa 23.40 21.75 20.25 18.75 18.15 20.25 22.50 26.30 x 0 0.129 0.228 0.353 0.511 0.700 0.810 1 y 0 0.065 0.145 0.285 0.535 0.805 0.915 1 Compute the activity coefficients of both components on the basis of Raoult’s law. 5.13‡ Chen and Lee studied the liquid–vapour equilibria of cyclohexanol with several gases at elevated pressures (J.-T. Chen and M.-J. Lee, J. Chem. Eng. Data 41, 339 (1996)). Among their data are the following measurements of the mole fractions of cyclohexanol in the vapour phase (y) and the liquid phase (x) at 393.15 K as a function of pressure. p/bar 10.0 20.0 30.0 40.0 60.0 80.0 ycyc 0.0267 0.0149 0.0112 0.00947 0.00835 0.00921 xcyc 0.9741 0.9464 0.9204 0.892 0.836 0.773 Determine the Henry’s law constant of CO2 in cyclohexanol, and compute the activity coefficient of CO2. 5.14‡ Equation 5.39 indicates that solubility is an exponential function of temperature. The data in the table below gives the solubility, S, of calcium acetate in water as a function of temperature. θ/°C 0 20 40 60 80 S/(mol dm−3 ) 36.4 34.9 33.7 32.7 31.7 Determine the extent to which the data fit the exponential S = S0eτ/T and obtain values for S0 and τ. Express these constants in terms of properties of the solute. 5.15 The excess Gibbs energy of solutions of methylcyclohexane (MCH) and tetrahydrofuran (THF) at 303.15 K was found to fit the expression GE = RTx(1 − x){0.4857 − 0.1077(2x − 1) + 0.0191(2x − 1)2 } where x is the mole fraction of the methylcyclohexane. Calculate the Gibbs energy of mixing when a mixture of 1.00 mol of MCH and 3.00 mol of THF is prepared. 5.16 The mean activity coefficients for aqueous solutions of NaCl at 25°C are given below. Confirm that they support the Debye–Hückel limiting law and that an improved fit is obtained with the extended law. b/(mmol kg−1 ) 1.0 2.0 5.0 10.0 20.0 γ± 0.9649 0.9519 0.9275 0.9024 0.8712 Theoretical problems 5.17 The excess Gibbs energy of a certain binary mixture is equal to gRTx(1 − x) where g is a constant and x is the mole fraction of a solute A. Find an expression for the chemical potential of A in the mixture and sketch its dependence on the composition. 5.18 Use the Gibbs–Duhem equation to derive the Gibbs–Duhem–Margules equation p,T = p,T where f is the fugacity. Use the relation to show that, when the fugacities are replaced by pressures, if Raoult’s law applies to one component in a mixture it must also apply to the other. 5.19 Use the Gibbs–Duhem equation to show that the partial molar volume (or any partial molar property) of a component B can be obtained if the partial molar volume (or other property) of A is known for all compositions up to the one of interest. Do this by proving that VB = V*B − Ύ VA VA* dVA Use the following data (which are for 298 K) to evaluate the integral graphically to find the partial molar volume of acetone at x = 0.500. x(CHCl3) 0 0.194 0.385 0.559 0.788 0.889 1.000 Vm/(cm3 mol−1 ) 73.99 75.29 76.50 77.55 79.08 79.82 80.67 5.20 Use the Gibbs–Helmholtz equation to find an expression for d ln xA in terms of dT. Integrate d ln xA from xA = 0 to the value of interest, and integrate the right–hand side from the transition temperature for the pure liquid A to the value in the solution. Show that, if the enthalpy of transition is constant, then eqns 5.33 and 5.36 are obtained. 5.21 The ‘osmotic coefficient’, φ, is defined as φ = −(xA/xB) ln aA. By writing r = xB/xA, and using the Gibbs–Duhem equation, show that we can calculate the activity of B from the activities of A over a composition range by using the formula ln = φ − φ(0) + Ύ r 0 dr 5.22 Show that the osmotic pressure of a real solution is given by ΠV = −RT ln aA. Go on to show that, provided the concentration of the solution is low, this expression takes the form ΠV = φRT[B] and hence that the osmotic coefficient, φ, (which is defined in Problem 5.21) may be determined from osmometry. 5.23 Show that the freezing-point depression of a real solution in which the solvent of molar mass M has activity aA obeys = − and use the Gibbs–Duhem equation to show that = − where aB is the solute activity and bB is its molality. Use the Debye–Hückel limiting law to show that the osmotic coefficient (φ, Problem 5.21) is given by φ = 1 − 1 –3 A′I with A′ = 2.303A and I = b/b7 . Applications: to biology and polymer science 5.24 Haemoglobin, the red blood protein responsible for oxygen transport, binds about 1.34 cm3 of oxygen per gram. Normal blood has a haemoglobin concentration of 150 g dm−3 . Haemoglobin in the lungs is about 97 per cent saturated with oxygen, but in the capillary is only about 75 per cent saturated. 1 bBKf d ln aB d(∆T) M Kf d ln aA d(∆T) D E F φ − 1 r A B C D E F aB r A B C xA 1 − xA D E F ∂ ln fB ∂ ln xB A B C D E F ∂ ln fA ∂ ln xA A B C PROBLEMS 173 What volume of oxygen is given up by 100 cm3 of blood flowing from the lungs in the capillary? 5.25 For the calculation of the solubility c of a gas in a solvent, it is often convenient to use the expression c = Kp, where K is the Henry’s law constant. Breathing air at high pressures, such as in scuba diving, results in an increased concentration of dissolved nitrogen. The Henry’s law constant for the solubility of nitrogen is 0.18 µg/(g H2O atm). What mass of nitrogen is dissolved in 100 g of water saturated with air at 4.0 atm and 20°C? Compare your answer to that for 100 g of water saturated with air at 1.0 atm. (Air is 78.08 mole per cent N2.) If nitrogen is four times as soluble in fatty tissues as in water, what is the increase in nitrogen concentration in fatty tissue in going from 1 atm to 4 atm? 5.26 Ethidium bromide binds to DNA by a process called intercalation, in which the aromatic ethidium cation fits between two adjacent DNA base pairs. An equilibrium dialysis experiment was used to study the binding of ethidium bromide (EB) to a short piece of DNA. A 1.00 µmol dm−3 aqueous solution of the DNA sample was dialysed against an excess of EB. The following data were obtained for the total concentration of EB: [EB]/(µmol dm−3 ) Side without DNA 0.042 0.092 0.204 0.526 1.150 Side with DNA 0.292 0.590 1.204 2.531 4.150 From these data, make a Scatchard plot and evaluate the intrinsic equilibrium constant, K, and total number of sites per DNA molecule. Is the identical and independent sites model for binding applicable? 5.27 The form of the Scatchard equation given in Impact I5.2 applies only when the macromolecule has identical and independent binding sites. For non-identical independent binding sites, the Scatchard equation is = ∑i Plot ν/[A] for the following cases. (a) There are four independent sites on an enzyme molecule and the intrinsic binding constant is K = 1.0 × 107 . (b) There are a total of six sites per polymer. Four of the sites are identical and have an intrinsic binding constant of 1 × 105 . The binding constants for the other two sites are 2 × 106 . 5.28 The addition of a small amount of a salt, such as (NH4)2SO4, to a solution containing a charged protein increases the solubility of the protein in water. This observation is called the salting-in effect. However, the addition of large amounts of salt can decrease the solubility of the protein to such an extent that the protein precipitates from solution. This observation is called NiKi 1 + Ki[A]out ν [A]out the salting-out effect and is used widely by biochemists to isolate and purify proteins. Consider the equilibrium PXν(s) 5 Pν+ (aq) + νX− (aq), where Pν+ is a polycationic protein of charge +ν and X− is its counter ion. Use Le Chatelier’s principle and the physical principles behind the Debye–Hückel theory to provide a molecular interpretation for the salting-in and salting-out effects. 5.29‡ Polymer scientists often report their data in rather strange units. For example, in the determination of molar masses of polymers in solution by osmometry, osmotic pressures are often reported in grams per square centimetre (g cm−2 ) and concentrations in grams per cubic centimetre (g cm−3 ). (a) With these choices of units, what would be the units of R in the van’t Hoff equation? (b) The data in the table below on the concentration dependence of the osmotic pressure of polyisobutene in chlorobenzene at 25°C have been adapted from J. Leonard and H. Daoust (J. Polymer Sci. 57, 53 (1962)). From these data, determine the molar mass of polyisobutene by plotting Π/c against c. (c) Theta solvents are solvents for which the second osmotic coefficient is zero; for ‘poor’ solvents the plot is linear and for good solvents the plot is nonlinear. From your plot, how would you classify chlorobenzene as a solvent for polyisobutene? Rationalize the result in terms of the molecular structure of the polymer and solvent. (d) Determine the second and third osmotic virial coefficients by fitting the curve to the virial form of the osmotic pressure equation. (e) Experimentally, it is often found that the virial expansion can be represented as Π/c = RT/M (1 + B′c + gB′2 c′2 + · · · ) and in good solvents, the parameter g is often about 0.25. With terms beyond the second power ignored, obtain an equation for (Π/c)1/2 and plot this quantity against c. Determine the second and third virial coefficients from the plot and compare to the values from the first plot. Does this plot confirm the assumed value of g? 10−2 (Π/c)/(g cm−2 /g cm−3 ) 2.6 2.9 3.6 4.3 6.0 12.0 c/(g cm−3 ) 0.0050 0.010 0.020 0.033 0.057 0.10 10−2 (Π/c)/(g cm−2 /g cm−3 ) 19.0 31.0 38.0 52 63 c/(g cm−3 ) 0.145 0.195 0.245 0.27 0.29 5.30‡ K. Sato, F.R. Eirich, and J.E. Mark (J. Polymer Sci., Polym. Phys. 14, 619 (1976)) have reported the data in the table below for the osmotic pressures of polychloroprene (ρ = 1.25 g cm−3 ) in toluene (ρ = 0.858 g cm−3 ) at 30°C. Determine the molar mass of polychloroprene and its second osmotic virial coefficient. c/(mg cm−3 ) 1.33 2.10 4.52 7.18 9.87 Π/(N m−2 ) 30 51 132 246 390 Phase diagrams Phase diagrams for pure substances were introduced in Chapter 4. Now we develop their use systematically and show how they are rich summaries of empirical information about a wide range of systems. To set the stage, we introduce the famous phase rule of Gibbs, which shows the extent to which various parameters can be varied yet the equilibrium between phases preserved. With the rule established, we see how it can be used to discuss the phase diagrams that we met in the two preceding chapters. The chapter then introduces systems of gradually increasing complexity. In each case we shall see how the phase diagram for the system summarizes empirical observations on the conditions under which the various phases of the system are stable. In this chapter we describe a systematic way of discussing the physical changes mixtures undergo when they are heated or cooled and when their compositions are changed. In particular, we see how to use phase diagrams to judge whether two substances are mutually miscible, whether an equilibrium can exist over a range of conditions, or whether the system must be brought to a definite pressure, temperature, and composition before equilibrium is established. Phase diagrams are of considerable commercial and industrial significance, particularly for semiconductors, ceramics, steels, and alloys. They are also the basis of separation procedures in the petroleum industry and of the formulation of foods and cosmetic preparations. Phases, components, and degrees of freedom All phase diagrams can be discussed in terms of a relationship, the phase rule, derived by J.W. Gibbs. We shall derive this rule first, and then apply it to a wide variety of systems. The phase rule requires a careful use of terms, so we begin by presenting a number of definitions. 6.1 Definitions The term phase was introduced at the start of Chapter 4, where we saw that it signifies a state of matter that is uniform throughout, not only in chemical composition but also in physical state.1 Thus we speak of the solid, liquid, and gas phases of a substance, and of its various solid phases (as for black phosphorus and white phosphorus). The number of phases in a system is denoted P. A gas, or a gaseous mixture, is a single phase, a crystal is a single phase, and two totally miscible liquids form a single phase. Phases, components, and degrees of freedom 6.1 Definitions 6.2 The phase rule Two-component systems 6.3 Vapour pressure diagrams 6.4 Temperature–composition diagrams 6.5 Liquid–liquid phase diagrams 6.6 Liquid–solid phase diagrams I6.1 Impact on materials science: Liquid crystals I6.2 Impact on materials science: Ultrapurity and controlled impurity Checklist of key ideas Further reading Discussion questions Exercises Problems 6 1 The words are Gibbs’s. 6.1 DEFINITIONS 175 A solution of sodium chloride in water is a single phase. Ice is a single phase (P = 1) even though it might be chipped into small fragments. A slurry of ice and water is a two-phase system (P = 2) even though it is difficult to map the boundaries between the phases. A system in which calcium carbonate undergoes thermal decomposition consists of two solid phases (one consisting of calcium carbonate and the other of calcium oxide) and one gaseous phase (consisting of carbon dioxide). An alloy of two metals is a two-phase system (P = 2) if the metals are immiscible, but a single-phase system (P = 1) if they are miscible. This example shows that it is not always easy to decide whether a system consists of one phase or of two. A solution of solid B in solid A—a homogeneous mixture of the two substances—is uniform on a molecular scale. In a solution, atoms of A are surrounded by atoms of A and B, and any sample cut from the sample, however small, is representative of the composition of the whole. A dispersion is uniform on a macroscopic scale but not on a microscopic scale, for it consists of grains or droplets of one substance in a matrix of the other. A small sample could come entirely from one of the minute grains of pure A and would not be representative of the whole (Fig. 6.1). Dispersions are important because, in many advanced materials (including steels), heat treatment cycles are used to achieve the precipitation of a fine dispersion of particles of one phase (such as a carbide phase) within a matrix formed by a saturated solid solution phase. The ability to control this microstructure resulting from phase equilibria makes it possible to tailor the mechanical properties of the materials to a particular application. By a constituentof a system we mean a chemical species (an ion or a molecule) that is present. Thus, a mixture of ethanol and water has two constituents. A solution of sodium chloride has three constituents: water, Na+ ions, and Cl− ions. The term constituent should be carefully distinguished from ‘component’, which has a more technical meaning. A component is a chemically independent constituent of a system. The number of components, C, in a system is the minimum number of independent species necessary to define the composition of all the phases present in the system. When no reaction takes place and there are no other constraints (such as charge balance), the number of components is equal to the number of constituents. Thus, pure water is a one-component system (C = 1), because we need only the species H2O to specify its composition. Similarly, a mixture of ethanol and water is a twocomponent system (C = 2): we need the species H2O and C2H5OH to specify its composition. An aqueous solution of sodium chloride has two components because, by charge balance, the number of Na+ ions must be the same as the number of Cl− ions. A system that consists of hydrogen, oxygen, and water at room temperature has three components (C = 3), despite it being possible to form H2O from H2 and O2: under the conditions prevailing in the system, hydrogen and oxygen do not react to form water, so they are independent constituents. When a reaction can occur under the conditions prevailing in the system, we need to decide the minimum number of species that, after allowing for reactions in which one species is synthesized from others, can be used to specify the composition of all the phases. Consider, for example, the equilibrium CaCO3(s) 5 CaO(s) + CO2(g) Phase 1 Phase 2 Phase 3 in which there are three constituents and three phases. To specify the composition of the gas phase (Phase 3) we need the species CO2, and to specify the composition of Phase 2 we need the species CaO. However, we do not need an additional species to specify the composition of Phase 1 because its identity (CaCO3) can be expressed in terms of the other two constituents by making use of the stoichiometry of the reaction. Hence, the system has only two components (C = 2). (a) (b) Fig. 6.1 The difference between (a) a singlephase solution, in which the composition is uniform on a microscopic scale, and (b) a dispersion, in which regions of one component are embedded in a matrix of a second component. 176 6 PHASE DIAGRAMS Comment 6.1 Josiah Willard Gibbs spent most of his working life at Yale, and may justly be regarded as the originator of chemical thermodynamics. He reflected for years before publishing his conclusions, and then did so in precisely expressed papers in an obscure journal (The Transactions of the Connecticut Academy of Arts and Sciences). He needed interpreters before the power of his work was recognized and before it could be applied to industrial processes. He is regarded by many as the first great American theoretical scientist. Example 6.1 Counting components How many components are present in a system in which ammonium chloride undergoes thermal decomposition? Method Begin by writing down the chemical equation for the reaction and identifying the constituents of the system (all the species present) and the phases. Then decide whether, under the conditions prevailing in the system, any of the constituents can be prepared from any of the other constituents. The removal of these constituents leaves the number of independent constituents. Finally, identify the minimum number of these independent constituents that are needed to specify the composition of all the phases. Answer The chemical reaction is NH4Cl(s) 5 NH3(g) + HCl(g) There are three constituents and two phases (one solid, one gas). However, NH3 and HCl are formed in fixed stoichiometric proportions by the reaction. Therefore, the compositions of both phases can be expressed in terms of the single species NH4Cl. It follows that there is only one component in the system (C = 1). If additional HCl (or NH3) were supplied to the system, the decomposition of NH4Cl would not give the correct composition of the gas phase and HCl (or NH3) would have to be invoked as a second component. Self-test 6.1 Give the number of components in the following systems: (a) water, allowing for its autoprotolysis, (b) aqueous acetic acid, (c) magnesium carbonate in equilibrium with its decomposition products. [(a) 1, (b) 2, (c) 2] The variance, F, of a system is the number of intensive variables that can be changed independently without disturbing the number of phases in equilibrium. In a single-component, single-phase system (C = 1, P = 1), the pressure and temperature may be changed independently without changing the number of phases, so F = 2. We say that such a system is bivariant, or that it has two degreesoffreedom. On the other hand, if two phases are in equilibrium (a liquid and its vapour, for instance) in a singlecomponent system (C = 1, P = 2), the temperature (or the pressure) can be changed at will, but the change in temperature (or pressure) demands an accompanying change in pressure (or temperature) to preserve the number of phases in equilibrium. That is, the variance of the system has fallen to 1. 6.2 The phase rule In one of the most elegant calculations of the whole of chemical thermodynamics, J.W. Gibbs deduced the phase rule, which is a general relation between the variance, F, the number of components, C, and the number of phases at equilibrium, P, for a system of any composition: F = C − P + 2 (6.1) Justification 6.1 The phase rule Consider first the special case of a one-component system. For two phases in equilibrium, we can write µJ(α) = µJ(β). Each chemical potential is a function of the pressure and temperature, so µJ(α; p,T) = µJ(β; p,T) 6.2 THE PHASE RULE 177 This is an equation relating p and T, so only one of these variables is independent (just as the equation x + y = 2 is a relation for y in terms of x: y = 2 − x). That conclusion is consistent with F = 1. For three phases in mutual equilibrium, µJ(α; p,T) = µJ(β; p,T) = µJ(γ; p,T) This relation is actually two equations for two unknowns (µJ(α; p,T) = µJ(β; p,T) and µJ(β; p,T) = µJ(γ; p,T)), and therefore has a solution only for a single value of p and T (just as the pair of equations x + y = 2 and 3x − y = 4 has the single solution x = 3 –2 and y = 1 –2). That conclusion is consistent with F = 0. Four phases cannot be in mutual equilibrium in a one-component system because the three equalities µJ(α; p,T) = µJ(β; p,T) µJ(β; p,T) = µJ(γ; p,T) µJ(γ; p,T) = µJ(δ; p,T) are three equations for two unknowns (p and T) and are not consistent (just as x + y = 2, 3x − y = 4, and x + 4y = 6 have no solution). Now consider the general case. We begin by counting the total number of intensive variables. The pressure, p, and temperature, T, count as 2. We can specify the composition of a phase by giving the mole fractions of C − 1 components. We need specify only C − 1 and not all C mole fractions because x1 + x2 + · · · + xC = 1, and all mole fractions are known if all except one are specified. Because there are P phases, the total number of composition variables is P(C − 1). At this stage, the total number of intensive variables is P(C − 1) + 2. At equilibrium, the chemical potential of a component J must be the same in every phase (Section 4.4): µJ(α) = µJ(β) = . . . for P phases That is, there are P − 1 equations of this kind to be satisfied for each component J. As there are C components, the total number of equations is C(P − 1). Each equation reduces our freedom to vary one of the P(C − 1) + 2 intensive variables. It follows that the total number of degrees of freedom is F = P(C − 1) + 2 − C(P − 1) = C − P + 2 which is eqn 6.1. (a) One-component systems For a one-component system, such as pure water, F = 3 − P. When only one phase is present, F = 2 and both p and T can be varied independently without changing the number of phases. In other words, a single phase is represented by an area on a phase diagram. When two phases are in equilibrium F = 1, which implies that pressure is not freely variable if the temperature is set; indeed, at a given temperature, a liquid has a characteristic vapour pressure. It follows that the equilibrium of two phases is represented by a line in the phase diagram. Instead of selecting the temperature, we could select the pressure, but having done so the two phases would be in equilibrium at a single definite temperature. Therefore, freezing (or any other phase transition) occurs at a definite temperature at a given pressure. When three phases are in equilibrium, F = 0 and the system is invariant. This special condition can be established only at a definite temperature and pressure that is characteristic of the substance and outside our control. The equilibrium of three phases is therefore represented by a point, the triple point, on a phase diagram. Four phases cannot be in equilibrium in a one-component system because F cannot be negative. These features are summarized in Fig. 6.2. We can identify the features in Fig. 6.2 in the experimentally determined phase diagram for water (Fig. 6.3). This diagram summarizes the changes that take place as a sample, such as that at a, is cooled at constant pressure. The sample remains entirely Temperature, T Pressure,p F = 1, two phases in equilibrium Phase Phase Phase Phase PhaseF = 2, one phase F = 0, three phases in equilibrium Four phases in equilibrium (forbidden) g e d a b Fig. 6.2 The typical regions of a onecomponent phase diagram. The lines represent conditions under which the two adjoining phases are in equilibrium. A point represents the unique set of conditions under which three phases coexist in equilibrium. Four phases cannot mutually coexist in equilibrium. Solid (ice) Liquid Vapour Tf T3 Tb Temperature, T Pressure,/atmp 1 d c b ae Fig. 6.3 The phase diagram for water, a simplified version of Fig. 4.5. The label T3 marks the temperature of the triple point, Tb the normal boiling point, and Tf the normal freezing point. 178 6 PHASE DIAGRAMS Tf Temperature,T d c e Time, t Liquid cooling Liquid freezing Solid cooling Fig. 6.4 The cooling curve for the isobar cde in Fig. 6.3. The halt marked d corresponds to the pause in the fall of temperature while the first-order exothermic transition (freezing) occurs. This pause enables Tf to be located even if the transition cannot be observed visually. Diamond anvils Piston Screw Fig. 6.5 Ultrahigh pressures (up to about 2 Mbar) can be achieved using a diamond anvil. The sample, together with a ruby for pressure measurement and a drop of liquid for pressure transmission, are placed between two gem-quality diamonds. The principle of its action is like that of a nutcracker: the pressure is exerted by turning the screw by hand. gaseous until the temperature reaches b, when liquid appears. Two phases are now in equilibrium and F = 1. Because we have decided to specify the pressure, which uses up the single degree of freedom, the temperature at which this equilibrium occurs is not under our control. Lowering the temperature takes the system to c in the one-phase, liquid region. The temperature can now be varied around the point c at will, and only when ice appears at d does the variance become 1 again. (b) Experimental procedures Detecting a phase change is not always as simple as seeing water boil in a kettle, so special techniques have been developed. Two techniques are thermal analysis, which takes advantage of the effect of the enthalpy change during a first-order transition (Section 4.7), and differential scanning calorimetry (see Impact I2.1). They are useful for solid–solid transitions, where simple visual inspection of the sample may be inadequate. In thermal analysis, a sample is allowed to cool and its temperature is monitored. At a first-order transition, heat is evolved and the cooling stops until the transition is complete. The cooling curve along the isobar cde in Fig. 6.3 therefore has the shape shown in Fig. 6.4. The transition temperature is obvious, and is used to mark point d on the phase diagram. Modern work on phase transitions often deals with systems at very high pressures, and more sophisticated detection procedures must be adopted. Some of the highest pressures currently attainable are produced in adiamond-anvilcell like that illustrated in Fig. 6.5. The sample is placed in a minute cavity between two gem-quality diamonds, and then pressure is exerted simply by turning the screw. The advance in design this represents is quite remarkable for, with a turn of the screw, pressures of up to about 1 Mbar can be reached that a few years ago could not be reached with equipment weighing tons. The pressure is monitored spectroscopically by observing the shift of spectral lines in small pieces of ruby added to the sample, and the properties of the sample itself are observed optically through the diamond anvils. One application of the technique is to study the transition of covalent solids to metallic solids. Iodine, I2, for instance, becomes metallic at around 200 kbar and makes a transition to a monatomic metallic 6.3 VAPOUR PRESSURE DIAGRAMS 179 solid at around 210 kbar. Studies such as these are relevant to the structure of material deep inside the Earth (at the centre of the Earth the pressure is around 5 Mbar) and in the interiors of the giant planets, where even hydrogen may be metallic. Two-component systems When two components are present in a system, C = 2 and F = 4 − P. If the temperature is constant, the remaining variance is F′ = 3 − P, which has a maximum value of 2. (The prime on F indicates that one of the degrees of freedom has been discarded, in this case the temperature.) One of these two remaining degrees of freedom is the pressure and the other is the composition (as expressed by the mole fraction of one component). Hence, one form of the phase diagram is a map of pressures and compositions at which each phase is stable. Alternatively, the pressure could be held constant and the phase diagram depicted in terms of temperature and composition. 6.3 Vapour pressure diagrams Thepartialvapourpressuresofthecomponentsofanidealsolutionoftwovolatileliquids are related to the composition of the liquid mixture by Raoult’s law (Section 5.3a) pA = xAp*A pB = xBp*B (6.2)° where p*A is the vapour pressure of pure A and p*B that of pure B. The total vapour pressure p of the mixture is therefore p = pA + pB = xAp*A + xBp*B = p*B + (p*A − p*B)xA (6.3)° This expression shows that the total vapour pressure (at some fixed temperature) changes linearly with the composition from p*B to p*A as xA changes from 0 to 1 (Fig. 6.6). (a) The composition of the vapour The compositions of the liquid and vapour that are in mutual equilibrium are not necessarily the same. Common sense suggests that the vapour should be richer in the more volatile component. This expectation can be confirmed as follows. The partial pressures of the components are given by eqn 6.2. It follows from Dalton’s law that the mole fractions in the gas, yA and yB, are yA = yB = (6.4) Provided the mixture is ideal, the partial pressures and the total pressure may be expressed in terms of the mole fractions in the liquid by using eqn 6.2 for pJ and eqn 6.3 for the total vapour pressure p, which gives yA = yB = 1 − yA (6.5)° Figure 6.7 shows the composition of the vapour plotted against the composition of the liquid for various values of p*A/p*B > 1. We see that in all cases yA > xA, that is, the vapour is richer than the liquid in the more volatile component. Note that if B is non-volatile, so that p*B = 0 at the temperature of interest, then it makes no contribution to the vapour (yB = 0). Equation 6.3 shows how the total vapour pressure of the mixture varies with the composition of the liquid. Because we can relate the composition of the liquid to the composition of the vapour through eqn 6.5, we can now also relate the total vapour pressure to the composition of the vapour: xAp*A p*B + (p*A − p*B)xA pB p pA p 0 1Mole fraction of A, xA pB* pA Liquid Vapour Pressure * Fig. 6.6 The variation of the total vapour pressure of a binary mixture with the mole fraction of A in the liquid when Raoult’s law is obeyed. 0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1 Mole fraction of A in liquid, xA MolefractionofAinvapour,yA 0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1 1 2 4 10 50 1000 Fig. 6.7 The mole fraction of A in the vapour of a binary ideal solution expressed in terms of its mole fraction in the liquid, calculated using eqn 6.5 for various values of p*A/p*B (the label on each curve) with A more volatile than B. In all cases the vapour is richer than the liquid in A. Exploration To reproduce the results of Fig. 6.7, first rearrange eqn 6.5 so that yA is expressed as a function of xA and the ratio p*A/p*B. Then plot yA against xA for several values of pA/pB > 1. 180 6 PHASE DIAGRAMS 0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1 Totalvapourpressure,/*ppA 0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1 Mole fraction of A in vapour, yA 1 2 4 10 30 1000 Fig. 6.8 The dependence of the vapour pressure of the same system as in Fig. 6.7, but expressed in terms of the mole fraction of A in the vapour by using eqn 6.6. Individual curves are labelled with the value of p*A/p*B. Exploration To reproduce the results of Fig. 6.8, first rearrange eqn 6.6 so that the ratio pA/p*A is expressed as a function of yA and the ratio p*A/p*B. Then plot pA/p*A against yA for several values of p*A/p*B > 1. 0 1 Mole fraction of A, zA pB pA Liquid Vapour Pressure,p a b xA yA * * Fig. 6.9 The dependence of the total vapour pressure of an ideal solution on the mole fraction of A in the entire system. A point between the two lines corresponds to both liquid and vapour being present; outside that region there is only one phase present. The mole fraction of A is denoted zA, as explained below. 0 1 Mole fraction of A, zA pB pA* Liquid Vapour Pressure a a1 a4 a2 a3 a2 a2¢ a3¢ a1¢ p1 p2 p3 * ¢¢ Fig. 6.10 The points of the pressure– composition diagram discussed in the text. The vertical line through a is an isopleth, a line of constant composition of the entire system. p = (6.6)° This expression is plotted in Fig. 6.8. (b) The interpretation of the diagrams If we are interested in distillation, both the vapour and the liquid compositions are of equal interest. It is therefore sensible to combine Figs. 6.7 and 6.8 into one (Fig. 6.9). The point a indicates the vapour pressure of a mixture of composition xA, and the point b indicates the composition of the vapour that is in equilibrium with the liquid at that pressure. Note that, when two phases are in equilibrium, P = 2 so F′ = 1 (as usual, the prime indicating that one degree of freedom, the temperature, has already been discarded). That is, if the composition is specified (so using up the only remaining degree of freedom), the pressure at which the two phases are in equilibrium is fixed. A richer interpretation of the phase diagram is obtained if we interpret the horizontal axis as showing the overall composition, zA, of the system. If the horizontal axis of the vapour pressure diagram is labelled with zA, then all the points down to the solid diagonal line in the graph correspond to a system that is under such high pressure that it contains only a liquid phase (the applied pressure is higher than the vapour pressure), so zA = xA, the composition of the liquid. On the other hand, all points below the lower curve correspond to a system that is under such low pressure that it contains only a vapour phase (the applied pressure is lower than the vapour pressure), so zA = yA. Points that lie between the two lines correspond to a system in which there are two phases present, one a liquid and the other a vapour. To see this interpretation, consider the effect of lowering the pressure on a liquid mixture of overall composition a in Fig. 6.10. The lowering of pressure can be achieved by drawing out a piston (Fig. 6.11). This degree of freedom is permitted by the phase rule because F′ = 2 when P = 1, and even if the composition is selected one degree of freedom remains. The changes to the system do not affect the overall composition, so the state of the system moves down the vertical line that passes through a. This vertical line is called an p*Ap*B p*A + (p*B − p*A)yA 6.3 VAPOUR PRESSURE DIAGRAMS 181 isopleth, from the Greek words for ‘equal abundance’. Until the point a1 is reached (when the pressure has been reduced to p1), the sample consists of a single liquid phase. At a1 the liquid can exist in equilibrium with its vapour. As we have seen, the composition of the vapour phase is given by point a1′. A line joining two points representing phases in equilibrium is called a tie line. The composition of the liquid is the same as initially (a1 lies on the isopleth through a), so we have to conclude that at this pressure there is virtually no vapour present; however, the tiny amount of vapour that is present has the composition a1′. Now consider the effect of lowering the pressure to p2, so taking the system to a pressure and overall composition represented by the point a2″. This new pressure is below the vapour pressure of the original liquid, so it vaporizes until the vapour pressure of the remaining liquid falls to p2. Now we know that the composition of such a liquid must be a2. Moreover, the composition of the vapour in equilibrium with that liquid must be given by the point a2′ at the other end of the tie line. Note that two phases are now in equilibrium, so F′ = 1 for all points between the two lines; hence, for a given pressure (such as at p2) the variance is zero, and the vapour and liquid phases have fixed compositions (Fig. 6.12). If the pressure is reduced to p3, a similar readjustment in composition takes place, and now the compositions of the liquid and vapour are represented by the points a3 and a3′, respectively. The latter point corresponds to a system in which the composition of the vapour is the same as the overall composition, so we have to conclude that the amount of liquid present is now virtually zero, but the tiny amount of liquid present has the composition a3. A further decrease in pressure takes the system to the point a4; at this stage, only vapour is present and its composition is the same as the initial overall composition of the system (the composition of the original liquid). (c) The lever rule A point in the two-phase region of a phase diagram indicates not only qualitatively that both liquid and vapour are present, but represents quantitatively the relative amounts of each. To find the relative amounts of two phases α and β that are in equilibrium, we measure the distances lα and lβ along the horizontal tie line, and then use the lever rule (Fig. 6.13): (a) (b) (c) Fig. 6.11 (a) A liquid in a container exists in equilibrium with its vapour. The superimposed fragment of the phase diagram shows the compositions of the two phases and their abundances (by the lever rule). (b) When the pressure is changed by drawing out a piston, the compositions of the phases adjust as shown by the tie line in the phase diagram. (c) When the piston is pulled so far out that all the liquid has vaporized and only the vapour is present, the pressure falls as the piston is withdrawn and the point on the phase diagram moves into the one-phase region. Pressure Composition One phase, = 2F One phase, = 2F Tw o phases, = 1 F Fig. 6.12 The general scheme of interpretation of a pressure–composition diagram (a vapour pressure diagram). Pressure Composition na la lb nb a b Fig. 6.13 The lever rule. The distances lα and lβ are used to find the proportions of the amounts of phases α (such as vapour) and β (for example, liquid) present at equilibrium. The lever rule is so called because a similar rule relates the masses at two ends of a lever to their distances from a pivot (mαlα = mβlβ for balance). 182 6 PHASE DIAGRAMS Comment 6.2 The textbook’s web site contains links to online databases of phase diagrams. Vapour composition Boiling temperature of liquid Temperature,T 0 1Mole fraction of A, zA T2 T3 a2¢ a3¢a3 a2 a1 a4 Fig. 6.14 The temperature–composition diagram corresponding to an ideal mixture with the component A more volatile than component B. Successive boilings and condensations of a liquid originally of composition a1 lead to a condensate that is pure A. The separation technique is called fractional distillation. nαlα = nβlβ (6.7) Here nα is the amount of phase α and nβ the amount of phase β. In the case illustrated in Fig. 6.13, because lβ ≈ 2lα, the amount of phase α is about twice the amount of phase β. Justification 6.2 The lever rule To prove the lever rule we write n = nα + nβ and the overall amount of A as nzA. The overall amount of A is also the sum of its amounts in the two phases: nzA = nαxA + nβyA Since also nzA = nαzA + nβzA by equating these two expressions it follows that nα(xA − zA) = nβ(zA − yA) which corresponds to eqn 6.7. Illustration 6.1 Using the lever rule At p1 in Fig. 6.10, the ratio lvap/lliq is almost infinite for this tie line, so nliq/nvap is also almost infinite, and there is only a trace of vapour present. When the pressure is reduced to p2, the value of lvap/lliq is about 0.3, so nliq/nvap ≈ 0.3 and the amount of liquid is about 0.3 times the amount of vapour. When the pressure has been reduced to p3, the sample is almost completely gaseous and because lvap/lliq ≈ 0 we conclude that there is only a trace of liquid present. 6.4 Temperature–composition diagrams To discuss distillation we need a temperature–compositiondiagram, a phase diagram in which the boundaries show the composition of the phases that are in equilibrium at various temperatures (and a given pressure, typically 1 atm). An example is shown in Fig. 6.14. Note that the liquid phase now lies in the lower part of the diagram. (a) The distillation of mixtures The region between the lines in Fig. 6.14 is a two-phase region where F′ = 1. As usual, the prime indicates that one degree of freedom has been discarded; in this case, the pressure is being kept fixed, and hence at a given temperature the compositions of the phases in equilibrium are fixed. The regions outside the phase lines correspond to a single phase, so F′ = 2, and the temperature and composition are both independently variable. Consider what happens when a liquid of composition a1 is heated. It boils when the temperature reaches T2. Then the liquid has composition a2 (the same as a1) and the vapour (which is present only as a trace) has composition a2′. The vapour is richer in the more volatile component A (the component with the lower boiling point). From the location of a2, we can state the vapour’s composition at the boiling point, and from the location of the tie line joining a2 and a2′ we can read off the boiling temperature (T2) of the original liquid mixture. 6.4 TEMPERATURE–COMPOSITION DIAGRAMS 183 In a simple distillation, the vapour is withdrawn and condensed. This technique is used to separate a volatile liquid from a non-volatile solute or solid. In fractional distillation, the boiling and condensation cycle is repeated successively. This technique is used to separate volatile liquids. We can follow the changes that occur by seeing what happens when the first condensate of composition a3 is reheated. The phase diagram shows that this mixture boils at T3 and yields a vapour of composition a3′, which is even richer in the more volatile component. That vapour is drawn off, and the first drop condenses to a liquid of composition a4. The cycle can then be repeated until in due course almost pure A is obtained. The efficiency of a fractionating column is expressed in terms of the number of theoretical plates, the number of effective vaporization and condensation steps that are required to achieve a condensate of given composition from a given distillate. Thus, to achieve the degree of separation shown in Fig. 6.15a, the fractionating column must correspond to three theoretical plates. To achieve the same separation for the system shown in Fig. 6.15b, in which the components have more similar partial pressures, the fractionating column must be designed to correspond to five theoretical plates. (b) Azeotropes Although many liquids have temperature–composition phase diagrams resembling the ideal version in Fig. 6.14, in a number of important cases there are marked deviations. A maximum in the phase diagram (Fig. 6.16) may occur when the favourable interactions between A and B molecules reduce the vapour pressure of the mixture below the ideal value: in effect, the A–B interactions stabilize the liquid. In such cases the excess Gibbs energy, GE (Section 5.4), is negative (more favourable to mixing than ideal). Examples of this behaviour include trichloromethane/propanone and nitric acid/water mixtures. Phase diagrams showing a minimum (Fig. 6.17) indicate that the mixture is destabilized relative to the ideal solution, the A–B interactions then being unfavourable. For such mixtures GE is positive (less favourable to mixing than ideal), and there may be contributions from both enthalpy and entropy effects. Examples include dioxane/water and ethanol/water mixtures. Temperature,TTemperature,T Composition Composition A A B B (a) (b) 2 2 3 3 1 1 4 5 Fig. 6.15 The number of theoretical plates is the number of steps needed to bring about a specified degree of separation of two components in a mixture. The two systems shown correspond to (a) 3, (b) 5 theoretical plates. Vapour composition Boiling temperature of liquid Temperature,T 0 1Mole fraction of A, zA a a2 a2¢ a3 a4 a3¢ a4¢ b Vapour composition Boiling temperature of liquid Temperature,T 0 1 Mole fraction of A, zA a2¢ a2 a1 a3 a4 a3¢ ab Fig. 6.16 A high-boiling azeotrope. When the liquid of composition a is distilled, the composition of the remaining liquid changes towards b but no further. Fig. 6.17 A low-boiling azeotrope. When the mixture at a is fractionally distilled, the vapour in equilibrium in the fractionating column moves towards b and then remains unchanged. 184 6 PHASE DIAGRAMS Deviations from ideality are not always so strong as to lead to a maximum or minimum in the phase diagram, but when they do there are important consequences for distillation. Consider a liquid of composition a on the right of the maximum in Fig. 6.16. The vapour (at a2′) of the boiling mixture (at a2) is richer in A. If that vapour is removed (and condensed elsewhere), then the remaining liquid will move to a composition that is richer in B, such as that represented by a3, and the vapour in equilibrium with this mixture will have composition a3′. As that vapour is removed, the composition of the boiling liquid shifts to a point such as a4, and the composition of the vapour shifts to a4′. Hence, as evaporation proceeds, the composition of the remaining liquid shifts towards B as A is drawn off. The boiling point of the liquid rises, and the vapour becomes richer in B. When so much A has been evaporated that the liquid has reached the composition b, the vapour has the same composition as the liquid. Evaporation then occurs without change of composition. The mixture is said to form an azeotrope.2 When the azeotropic composition has been reached, distillation cannot separate the two liquids because the condensate has the same composition as the azeotropic liquid. One example of azeotrope formation is hydrochloric acid/water, which is azeotropic at 80 per cent by mass of water and boils unchanged at 108.6°C. The system shown in Fig. 6.17 is also azeotropic, but shows its azeotropy in a different way. Suppose we start with a mixture of composition a1, and follow the changes in the composition of the vapour that rises through a fractionating column (essentially a vertical glass tube packed with glass rings to give a large surface area). The mixture boils at a2 to give a vapour of composition a2′. This vapour condenses in the column to a liquid of the same composition (now marked a3). That liquid reaches equilibrium with its vapour at a3′, which condenses higher up the tube to give a liquid of the same composition, which we now call a4. The fractionation therefore shifts the vapour towards the azeotropic composition at b, but not beyond, and the azeotropic vapour emerges from the top of the column. An example is ethanol/water, which boils unchanged when the water content is 4 per cent by mass and the temperature is 78°C. (c) Immiscible liquids Finally we consider the distillation of two immiscible liquids, such as octane and water. At equilibrium, there is a tiny amount of A dissolved in B, and similarly a tiny amount of B dissolved in A: both liquids are saturated with the other component (Fig. 6.18a). As a result, the total vapour pressure of the mixture is close to p = pA* + pB*. If the temperature is raised to the value at which this total vapour pressure is equal to the atmospheric pressure, boiling commences and the dissolved substances are purged from their solution. However, this boiling results in a vigorous agitation of the mixture, so each component is kept saturated in the other component, and the purging continues as the very dilute solutions are replenished. This intimate contact is essential: two immiscible liquids heated in a container like that shown in Fig. 6.18b would not boil at the same temperature. The presence of the saturated solutions means that the ‘mixture’ boils at a lower temperature than either component would alone because boiling begins when the total vapour pressure reaches 1 atm, not when either vapour pressure reaches 1 atm. This distinction is the basis of steam distillation, which enables some heat-sensitive, water-insoluble organic compounds to be distilled at a lower temperature than their normal boiling point. The only snag is that the composition of the condensate is in proportion to the vapour pressures of the components, so oils of low volatility distil in low abundance. 2 The name comes from the Greek words for ‘boiling without changing’. (a) (b) Fig. 6.18 The distillation of (a) two immiscible liquids can be regarded as (b) the joint distillation of the separated components, and boiling occurs when the sum of the partial pressures equals the external pressure. 6.5 LIQUID–LIQUID PHASE DIAGRAMS 185 P = 1 P = 2 0 1 Mole fraction of nitrobenzene, xB Tuc Temperature,T a¢ a a² A B Composition of one phase Composition of second phase Fig. 6.19 The temperature–composition diagram for hexane and nitrobenzene at 1 atm. The region below the curve corresponds to the compositions and temperatures at which the liquids are partially miscible. The upper critical temperature, Tuc, is the temperature above which the two liquids are miscible in all proportions. P = 1 P = 2 0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1 x(C H NO )6 5 2 290 292 273 l lb T/K a Fig. 6.20 The temperature–composition diagram for hexane and nitrobenzene at 1 atm again, with the points and lengths discussed in the text. 6.5 Liquid–liquid phase diagrams Now we consider temperature–composition diagrams for systems that consist of pairs of partially miscible liquids, which are liquids that do not mix in all proportions at all temperatures. An example is hexane and nitrobenzene. The same principles of interpretation apply as to liquid–vapour diagrams. When P = 2, F′ = 1 (the prime denoting the adoption of constant pressure), and the selection of a temperature implies that the compositions of the immiscible liquid phases are fixed. When P = 1 (corresponding to a system in which the two liquids are fully mixed), both the temperature and the composition may be adjusted. (a) Phase separation Suppose a small amount of a liquid B is added to a sample of another liquid A at a temperature T′. It dissolves completely, and the binary system remains a single phase. As more B is added, a stage comes at which no more dissolves. The sample now consists of two phases in equilibrium with each other (P = 2), the most abundant one consisting of A saturated with B, the minor one a trace of B saturated with A. In the temperature–composition diagram drawn in Fig. 6.19, the composition of the former is represented by the point a′ and that of the latter by the point a″. The relative abundances of the two phases are given by the lever rule. When more B is added, A dissolves in it slightly. The compositions of the two phases in equilibrium remain a′ and a″ because P = 2 implies that F′ = 0, and hence that the compositions of the phases are invariant at a fixed temperature and pressure. However, the amount of one phase increases at the expense of the other. A stage is reached when so much B is present that it can dissolve all the A, and the system reverts to a single phase. The addition of more B now simply dilutes the solution, and from then on it remains a single phase. The composition of the two phases at equilibrium varies with the temperature. For hexane and nitrobenzene, raising the temperature increases their miscibility. The twophase system therefore becomes less extensive, because each phase in equilibrium is richer in its minor component: the A-rich phase is richer in B and the B-rich phase is richer in A. We can construct the entire phase diagram by repeating the observations at different temperatures and drawing the envelope of the two-phase region. Example 6.2 Interpreting a liquid–liquid phase diagram A mixture of 50 g of hexane (0.59 mol C6H14) and 50 g of nitrobenzene (0.41 mol C6H5NO2) was prepared at 290 K. What are the compositions of the phases, and in what proportions do they occur? To what temperature must the sample be heated in order to obtain a single phase? Method The compositions of phases in equilibrium are given by the points where the tie-line representing the temperature intersects the phase boundary. Their proportions are given by the lever rule (eqn 6.7). The temperature at which the components are completely miscible is found by following the isopleth upwards and noting the temperature at which it enters the one-phase region of the phase diagram. Answer We denote hexane by H and nitrobenzene by N; refer to Fig. 6.20, which is a simplified version of Fig. 6.19. The point xN = 0.41, T = 290 K occurs in the two-phase region of the phase diagram. The horizontal tie line cuts the phase 186 6 PHASE DIAGRAMS 300 200 100 Hydride 0 0.5 1 Temperature,/°C Solid solution Mole fraction of H, xH Tuc q Fig. 6.21 The phase diagram for palladium and palladium hydride, which has an upper critical temperature at 300°C. Comment 6.3 This expression is an example of a transcendental equation, an equation that does not have a solution that can be expressed in a closed form. The solutions can be found numerically by using mathematical software or by plotting the first term against the second and identifying the points of intersection as β is changed. Comment 6.4 The upper critical solution temperature and the lower critical solution temperature are also called the ‘upper consolute temperature’ and ‘lower consolute temperature’, respectively. boundary at xN = 0.35 and xN = 0.83, so those are the compositions of the two phases. According to the lever rule, the ratio of amounts of each phase is equal to the ratio of the distances lα and lβ: = = = = 7 That is, there is about 7 times more hexane-rich phase than nitrobenzene-rich phase. Heating the sample to 292 K takes it into the single-phase region. Because the phase diagram has been constructed experimentally, these conclusions are not based on any assumptions about ideality. They would be modified if the system were subjected to a different pressure. Self-test 6.2 Repeat the problem for 50 g of hexane and 100 g of nitrobenzene at 273 K. [xN = 0.09 and 0.95 in ratio 1:1.3; 294 K] (b) Critical solution temperatures The upper critical solution temperature, Tuc, is the highest temperature at which phase separation occurs. Above the upper critical temperature the two components are fully miscible. This temperature exists because the greater thermal motion overcomes any potential energy advantage in molecules of one type being close together. One example is the nitrobenzene/hexane system shown in Fig. 6.19. An example of a solid solution is the palladium/hydrogen system, which shows two phases, one a solid solution of hydrogen in palladium and the other a palladium hydride, up to 300°C but forms a single phase at higher temperatures (Fig. 6.21). The thermodynamic interpretation of the upper critical solution temperature focuses on the Gibbs energy of mixing and its variation with temperature. We saw in Section 5.4 that a simple model of a real solution results in a Gibbs energy of mixing that behaves as shown in Fig. 5.20. Provided the parameter β that was introduced in eqn 5.30 is greater than 2, the Gibbs energy of mixing has a double minimum (Fig. 6.22). As a result, for β > 2 we can expect phase separation to occur. The same model shows that the compositions corresponding to the minima are obtained by looking for the conditions at which ∂∆mixG/∂x = 0, and a simple manipulation of eqn 5.31 shows that we have to solve ln + β(1 − 2x) = 0 The solutions are plotted in Fig. 6.23. We see that, as β decreases, which can be interpreted as an increase in temperature provided the intermolecular forces remain constant, then the two minima move together and merge when β = 2. Some systems show a lower critical solution temperature, Tlc, below which they mix in all proportions and above which they form two phases. An example is water and triethylamine (Fig. 6.24). In this case, at low temperatures the two components are more miscible because they form a weak complex; at higher temperatures the complexes break up and the two components are less miscible. Some systems have both upper and lower critical solution temperatures. They occur because, after the weak complexes have been disrupted, leading to partial miscibility, the thermal motion at higher temperatures homogenizes the mixture again, just as in the case of ordinary partially miscible liquids. The most famous example is nicotine and water, which are partially miscible between 61°C and 210°C (Fig. 6.25). x 1 − x 0.42 0.06 0.83 − 0.41 0.41 − 0.35 lβ lα nα nβ 6.5 LIQUID–LIQUID PHASE DIAGRAMS 187 (c) The distillation of partially miscible liquids Consider a pair of liquids that are partially miscible and form a low-boiling azeotrope. This combination is quite common because both properties reflect the tendency of the two kinds of molecule to avoid each other. There are two possibilities: one in which the liquids become fully miscible before they boil; the other in which boiling occurs before mixing is complete. Figure 6.26 shows the phase diagram for two components that become fully miscible before they boil. Distillation of a mixture of composition a1 leads to a vapour of composition b1, which condenses to the completely miscible single-phase solution at b2. Phase separation occurs only when this distillate is cooled to a point in the two-phase liquid region, such as b3. This description applies only to the first drop of distillate. If distillation continues, the composition of the remaining liquid changes. In the end, when the whole sample has evaporated and condensed, the composition is back to a1. Figure 6.27 shows the second possibility, in which there is no upper critical solution temperature. The distillate obtained from a liquid initially of composition a1 has composition b3 and is a two-phase mixture. One phase has composition b3′ and the other has composition b3″. The behaviour of a system of composition represented by the isopleth e in Fig. 6.27 is interesting. A system at e1 forms two phases, which persist (but with changing proportions) up to the boiling point at e2. The vapour of this mixture has the same 0 DmixGnRT/ 0 0.5 1 xA 1 1.5 2 2.5 3 -0.5 -0.4 -0.3 -0.2 -0.1 +0.1 Fig. 6.22 The temperature variation of the Gibbs energy of mixing of a system that is partially miscible at low temperatures. A system of composition in the region P = 2 forms two phases with compositions corresponding to the two local minima of the curve. This illustration is a duplicate of Fig. 5.20. Exploration Working from eqn 5.31, write an expression for Tmin, the temperature at which ∆mixG has a minimum, as a function of β and xA. Then, plot Tmin against xA for several values of β. Provide a physical interpretation for any maxima or minima that you observe in these plots. 0 0.5 1 xA 2 2.5 3 b Fig. 6.23 The location of the phase boundary as computed on the basis of the β-parameter model introduced in Section 5.4. Exploration Using mathematical software or an electronic spreadsheet, generate the plot of β against xA by one of two methods: (a) solve the transcendental equation ln {(x/(1− x)} + β(1 − 2x) = 0 numerically, or (b) plot the first term of the transcendental equation against the second and identify the points of intersection as β is changed. P = 1 P = 2 0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1 Mole fraction of triethylamine, ((C H ) N)x 2 5 3 Temperature,T Tlc H O2 (C H ) N2 5 3 Composition of second phase Composition of one phase Fig. 6.24 The temperature–composition diagram for water and triethylamine. This system shows a lower critical temperature at 292 K. The labels indicate the interpretation of the boundaries. P = 1 P = 2 0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1 Mole fraction of nicotine, xN Temperature,/°C Tlc H O2 Nicotine Tuc 61 210 q Fig. 6.25 The temperature–composition diagram for water and nicotine, which has both upper and lower critical temperatures. Note the high temperatures for the liquid (especially the water): the diagram corresponds to a sample under pressure. 188 6 PHASE DIAGRAMS 0 1Mole fraction of B, xB Temperature,T Vapour, = 1P Liquid, = 1P b1 b2 a2 a1b3 Liquid, = 2P A B P = 2P = 2 0 1 Mole fraction of B, xB Temperature,T Vapour, = 1P Liquid, = 1P b1 a2 a1 b3 Liquid, = 2P A B e3 e2 e1 b3¢ b3² Fig. 6.26 The temperature–composition diagram for a binary system in which the upper critical temperature is less than the boiling point at all compositions. The mixture forms a low-boiling azeotrope. Fig. 6.27 The temperature–composition diagram for a binary system in which boiling occurs before the two liquids are fully miscible. 0 1 Mole fraction of B, xB b1 a2 a1b3 A B b3 b3² 0.95 398 390 350 330 320 298 T/K 0.20 0.30 0.66 0.80 0.49 0.87 0.90¢ Fig. 6.28 The points of the phase diagram in Fig. 6.27 that are discussed in Example 6.3. composition as the liquid (the liquid is an azeotrope). Similarly, condensing a vapour of composition e3 gives a two-phase liquid of the same overall composition. At a fixed temperature, the mixture vaporizes and condenses like a single substance. Example 6.3 Interpreting a phase diagram State the changes that occur when a mixture of composition xB = 0.95 (a1) in Fig. 6.28 is boiled and the vapour condensed. Method The area in which the point lies gives the number of phases; the compositions of the phases are given by the points at the intersections of the horizontal tie line with the phase boundaries; the relative abundances are given by the lever rule (eqn 6.7). Answer The initial point is in the one-phase region. When heated it boils at 350 K (a2) giving a vapour of composition xB = 0.66 (b1). The liquid gets richer in B, and the last drop (of pure B) evaporates at 390 K. The boiling range of the liquid is therefore 350 to 390 K. If the initial vapour is drawn off, it has a composition xB = 0.66. This composition would be maintained if the sample were very large, but for a finite sample it shifts to higher values and ultimately to xB = 0.95. Cooling the distillate corresponds to moving down the xB = 0.66 isopleth. At 330 K, for instance, the liquid phase has composition xB = 0.87, the vapour xB = 0.49; their relative proportions are 1:3. At 320 K the sample consists of three phases: the vapour and two liquids. One liquid phase has composition xB = 0.30; the other has composition xB = 0.80 in the ratio 0.62:1. Further cooling moves the system into the two-phase region, and at 298 K the compositions are 0.20 and 0.90 in the ratio 0.82:1. As further distillate boils over, the overall composition of the distillate becomes richer in B. When the last drop has been condensed the phase composition is the same as at the beginning. Self-test 6.3 Repeat the discussion, beginning at the point xB = 0.4, T = 298 K. 6.6 LIQUID–SOLID PHASE DIAGRAMS 189 6.6 Liquid–solid phase diagrams Knowledge of the temperature–composition diagrams for solid mixtures guides the design of important industrial processes, such as the manufacture of liquid crystal displays and semiconductors. In this section, we shall consider systems where solid and liquid phases may both be present at temperatures below the boiling point. Consider the two-component liquid of composition a1 in Fig. 6.29. The changes that occur may be expressed as follows. 1. a1 → a2. The system enters the two-phase region labelled ‘Liquid + B’. Pure solid B begins to come out of solution and the remaining liquid becomes richer in A. 2. a2 → a3. More of the solid forms, and the relative amounts of the solid and liquid (which are in equilibrium) are given by the lever rule. At this stage there are roughly equal amounts of each. The liquid phase is richer in A than before (its composition is given by b3) because some B has been deposited. 3. a3 → a4. At the end of this step, there is less liquid than at a3, and its composition is given by e. This liquid now freezes to give a two-phase system of pure B and pure A. (a) Eutectics The isopleth at e in Fig. 6.29 corresponds to the eutectic composition, the mixture with the lowest melting point.3 A liquid with the eutectic composition freezes at a single temperature, without previously depositing solid A or B. A solid with the eutectic composition melts, without change of composition, at the lowest temperature of any mixture. Solutions of composition to the right of e deposit B as they cool, and solutions to the left deposit A: only the eutectic mixture (apart from pure A or pure B) solidifies at a single definite temperature (F′ = 0 when C = 2 and P = 3) without gradually unloading one or other of the components from the liquid. One technologically important eutectic is solder, which has mass composition of about 67 per cent tin and 33 per cent lead and melts at 183°C. The eutectic formed by 23 per cent NaCl and 77 per cent H2O by mass melts at −21.1°C. When salt is added to ice under isothermal conditions (for example, when spread on an icy road) the mixture melts if the temperature is above −21.1°C (and the eutectic composition has been achieved). When salt is added to ice under adiabatic conditions (for example, when added to ice in a vacuum flask) the ice melts, but in doing so it absorbs heat from the rest of the mixture. The temperature of the system falls and, if enough salt is added, cooling continues down to the eutectic temperature. Eutectic formation occurs in the great majority of binary alloy systems, and is of great importance for the microstructure of solid materials. Although a eutectic solid is a two-phase system, it crystallizes out in a nearly homogeneous mixture of microcrystals. The two microcrystalline phases can be distinguished by microscopy and structural techniques such as X-ray diffraction (Chapter 20). Thermal analysis is a very useful practical way of detecting eutectics. We can see how it is used by considering the rate of cooling down the isopleth through a1 in Fig. 6.29. The liquid cools steadily until it reaches a2, when B begins to be deposited (Fig. 6.30). Cooling is now slower because the solidification of B is exothermic and retards the cooling. When the remaining liquid reaches the eutectic composition, the temperature remains constant (F′ = 0) until the whole sample has solidified: this region of constant temperature is the eutectic halt. If the liquid has the eutectic composition e initially, the liquid cools steadily down to the freezing temperature of the eutectic, 0 1 Mole fraction of B, xB Temperature,T Liquid, = 1P a2 a1 b3 A B e Solid, = 2P a3 a4 a5 a5¢ a5² Liquid + A Liquid + B Fig. 6.29 The temperature–composition phase diagram for two almost immiscible solids and their completely miscible liquids. Note the similarity to Fig. 6.27. The isopleth through e corresponds to the eutectic composition, the mixture with lowest melting point. Temperature Time Composition Eutectic freezing a1 a2 a3 a4 a5 e Liquid cooling B precipitating Solid cooling Fig. 6.30 The cooling curves for the system shown in Fig. 6.29. For isopleth a, the rate of cooling slows at a2 because solid B deposits from solution. There is a complete halt at a4 while the eutectic solidifies. This halt is longest for the eutectic isopleth, e. The eutectic halt shortens again for compositions beyond e (richer in A). Cooling curves are used to construct the phase diagram.3 The name comes from the Greek words for ‘easily melted’. 190 6 PHASE DIAGRAMS Liquid, = 1P Solid, = 2P Solid, = 2P BCA a1 a2 a3 a4 e Temperature Composition Fig. 6.31 The phase diagram for a system in which A and B react to form a compound C = AB. This resembles two versions of Fig. 6.29 in each half of the diagram. The constituent C is a true compound, not just an equimolar mixture. Liquid, = 1P = 2P= 2P a2 a3 b2 b3 b4 K Na K2 Na T1 T2 T2 T3 T4 Liquid + solid Na K2 Liquid + solid Na containing some K Composition a1b1 Solid Na K + solid Na containing some K 2 Solid Na +solid Na containing some K Liquid + solid K containing some Na Solid K + solid K containing some Na Solid Na K + solid K containing some Na 2 ¢ Fig. 6.32 The phase diagram for an actual system (sodium and potassium) like that shown in Fig. 6.35, but with two differences. One is that the compound is Na2K, corresponding to A2B and not AB as in that illustration. The second is that the compound exists only as the solid, not as the liquid. The transformation of the compound at its melting point is an example of incongruent melting. when there is a long eutectic halt as the entire sample solidifies (like the freezing of a pure liquid). Monitoring the cooling curves at different overall compositions gives a clear indication of the structure of the phase diagram. The solid–liquid boundary is given by the points at which the rate of cooling changes. The longest eutectic halt gives the location of the eutectic composition and its melting temperature. (b) Reacting systems Many binary mixtures react to produce compounds, and technologically important examples of this behaviour include the III/V semiconductors, such as the gallium arsenide system, which forms the compound GaAs. Although three constituents are present, there are only two components because GaAs is formed from the reaction Ga + As 5 GaAs. We shall illustrate some of the principles involved with a system that forms a compound C that also forms eutectic mixtures with the species A and B (Fig. 6.31). A system prepared by mixing an excess of B with A consists of C and unreacted B. This is a binary B, C system, which we suppose forms a eutectic. The principal change from the eutectic phase diagram in Fig. 6.29 is that the whole of the phase diagram is squeezed into the range of compositions lying between equal amounts of A and B (xB = 0.5, marked C in Fig. 6.31) and pure B. The interpretation of the information in the diagram is obtained in the same way as for Fig. 6.32. The solid deposited on cooling along the isopleth a is the compound C. At temperatures below a4 there are two solid phases, one consisting of C and the other of B. The pure compound C melts congruently, that is, the composition of the liquid it forms is the same as that of the solid compound. (c) Incongruent melting In some cases the compound C is not stable as a liquid. An example is the alloy Na2K, which survives only as a solid (Fig. 6.32). Consider what happens as a liquid at a1 is cooled: 1. a1 → a2. Some solid Na is deposited, and the remaining liquid is richer in K. 2. a2 → just below a3. The sample is now entirely solid, and consists of solid Na and solid Na2K. 6.6 LIQUID–SOLID PHASE DIAGRAMS 191 Now consider the isopleth through b1: 1. b1 → b2. No obvious change occurs until the phase boundary is reached at b2 when solid Na begins to deposit. 2. b2 → b3. Solid Na deposits, but at b3 a reaction occurs to form Na2K: this compound is formed by the K atoms diffusing into the solid Na. 3. b3. At b3, three phases are in mutual equilibrium: the liquid, the compound Na2K, and solid Na. The horizontal line representing this three-phase equilibrium is called a peritectic line. At this stage the liquid Na/K mixture is in equilibrium with a little solid Na2K, but there is still no liquid compound. 4. b3 → b4. As cooling continues, the amount of solid compound increases until at b4 the liquid reaches its eutectic composition. It then solidifies to give a two-phase solid consisting of solid K and solid Na2K. If the solid is reheated, the sequence of events is reversed. No liquid Na2K forms at any stage because it is too unstable to exist as a liquid. This behaviour is an example of incongruent melting, in which a compound melts into its components and does not itself form a liquid phase. IMPACT ON MATERIALS SCIENCE I6.1 Liquid crystals A mesophase is a phase intermediate between solid and liquid. Mesophases are of great importance in biology, for they occur as lipid bilayers and in vesicular systems. A mesophase may arise when molecules have highly non-spherical shapes, such as being long and thin (1), or disk-like (2). When the solid melts, some aspects of the longrange order characteristic of the solid may be retained, and the new phase may be a liquid crystal, a substance having liquid-like imperfect long-range order in at least one direction in space but positional or orientational order in at least one other direction. Calamitic liquid crystals (from the Greek word for reed) are made from long and thin molecules, whereas discotic liquid crystals are made from disk-like molecules. A 192 6 PHASE DIAGRAMS thermotropic liquid crystal displays a transition to the liquid crystalline phase as the temperature is changed. A lyotropic liquid crystal is a solution that undergoes a transition to the liquid crystalline phase as the composition is changed. One type of retained long-range order gives rise to a smectic phase (from the Greek word for soapy), in which the molecules align themselves in layers (see Fig. 6.33). Other materials, and some smectic liquid crystals at higher temperatures, lack the layered structure but retain a parallel alignment; this mesophase is called a nematic phase (from the Greek for thread, which refers to the observed defect structure of the phase). In the cholesteric phase (from the Greek for bile solid) the molecules lie in sheets at angles that change slightly between each sheet. That is, they form helical structures with a pitch that depends on the temperature. As a result, cholesteric liquid crystals diffract light and have colours that depend on the temperature. Disk-like molecules such as (2) can form nematic and columnar mesophases. In the latter, the aromatic rings stack one on top of the other and are separated by very small distances (less than 0.5 nm). The optical properties of nematic liquid crystals are anisotropic, meaning that they depend on the relative orientation of the molecular assemblies with respect to the polarization of the incident beam of light. Nematic liquid crystals also respond in special ways to electric fields. Together, these unique optical and electrical properties form the basis of operation of liquid crystal displays (LCDs). In a ‘twisted nematic’ LCD, the liquid crystal is held between two flat plates about 10 µm apart. The inner surface of each plate is coated with a transparent conducting material, such as indium–tin oxide. The plates also have a surface that causes the liquid crystal to adopt a particular orientation at its interface and are typically set at 90° to each other but 270° in a‘supertwist’ arrangement. The entire assembly is set between two polarizers, optical filters that allow light of one one specific plane of polarization to pass. The incident light passes through the outer polarizer, then its plane of polarization is rotated as it passes through the twisted nematic and, depending on the setting of the second polarizer, will pass through (if that is how the second polarizer is arranged). When a potential difference is applied across the cell, the helical arrangement is lost and the plane of the light is no longer rotated and will be blocked by the second polarizer. Although there are many liquid crystalline materials, some difficulty is often experienced in achieving a technologically useful temperature range for the existence of the mesophase. To overcome this difficulty, mixtures can be used. An example of the type of phase diagram that is then obtained is shown in Fig. 6.34. As can be seen, the mesophase exists over a wider range of temperatures than either liquid crystalline material alone. IMPACT ON MATERIALS SCIENCE I6.2 Ultrapurity and controlled impurity Advances in technology have called for materials of extreme purity. For example, semiconductor devices consist of almost perfectly pure silicon or germanium doped to a precisely controlled extent. For these materials to operate successfully, the impurity level must be kept down to less than 1 ppb (1 part in 109 , which corresponds to 1 mg of impurity in 1 t of material, about a small grain of salt in 5 t of sugar).4 In the technique of zone refining the sample is in the form of a narrow cylinder. This cylinder is heated in a thin disk-like zone which is swept from one end of the sample to the other. The advancing liquid zone accumulates the impurities as it passes. In practice, a train of hot and cold zones are swept repeatedly from one end to the other 4 1 t = 103 kg. (a) (b) (c) Fig. 6.33 The arrangement of molecules in (a) the nematic phase, (b) the smectic phase, and (c) the cholesteric phase of liquid crystals. In the cholesteric phase, the stacking of layers continues to give a helical arrangement of molecules. CHECKLIST OF KEY IDEAS 193 as shown in Fig. 6.35. The zone at the end of the sample is the impurity dump: when the heater has gone by, it cools to a dirty solid which can be discarded. The technique makes use of the non-equilibrium properties of the system. It relies on the impurities being more soluble in the molten sample than in the solid, and sweeps them up by passing a molten zone repeatedly from one end to the other along a sample. The phase diagram in Fig. 6.36 gives some insight into the process. Consider a liquid (this represents the molten zone) on the isopleth through a1, and let it cool without the entire sample coming to overall equilibrium. If the temperature falls to a2 a solid of composition b2 is deposited and the remaining liquid (the zone where the heater has moved on) is at a2′. Cooling that liquid down an isopleth passing through a2′ deposits solid of composition b3 and leaves liquid at a3′. The process continues until the last drop of liquid to solidify is heavily contaminated with B. There is plenty of everyday evidence that impure liquids freeze in this way. For example, an ice cube is clear near the surface but misty in the core: the water used to make ice normally contains dissolved air; freezing proceeds from the outside, and air is accumulated in the retreating liquid phase. It cannot escape from the interior of the cube, and so when that freezes it occludes the air in a mist of tiny bubbles. A modification of zone refining is zone levelling. It is used to introduce controlled amounts of impurity (for example, of indium into germanium). A sample rich in the required dopant is put at the head of the main sample, and made molten. The zone is then dragged repeatedly in alternate directions through the sample, where it deposits a uniform distribution of the impurity. Checklist of key ideas 1. A phase is a state of matter that is uniform throughout, not only in chemical composition but also in physical state. 2. A constituent is a chemical species (an ion or a molecule). A component is a chemically independent constituent of a system. 3. The variance F, or degree of freedom, is the number of intensive variables that can be changed independently without disturbing the number of phases in equilibrium. 4. The phase rule states that F = C − P + 2. Liquid Solid Temperature,T Composition, xB BA a1 a2¢ a3¢a3 b1 b2 b3 a 0 1 a2 Fig. 6.36 A binary temperature– composition diagram can be used to discuss zone refining, as explained in the text. 160 140 120 100 /°C 0 0.5 1 xB Isotropic Nematic Solid solution Solid solution q Fig. 6.34 The phase diagram at 1 atm for a binary system of two liquid crystalline materials, 4,4′-dimethoxyazoxybenzene (A) and 4,4′-diethoxyazoxybenzene (B). Heating coil (a) (b) Purified material Collected impurities Fig. 6.35 The procedure for zone refining. (a) Initially, impurities are distributed uniformly along the sample. (b) After a molten zone is passed along the rod, the impurities are more concentrated at the right. In practice, a series of molten zones are passed along the rod from left to right. 194 6 PHASE DIAGRAMS Discussion questions 6.1 Define the following terms: phase, constituent, component, and degree of freedom. 6.2 What factors determine the number of theoretical plates required to achieve a desired degree of separation in fractional distillation? 6.3 Draw phase diagrams for the following types of systems. Label the regions and intersections of the diagrams, stating what materials (possibly compounds or azeotropes) are present and whether they are solid liquid or gas. (a) Onecomponent, pressure–temperature diagram, liquid density greater than that of solid. (b) Two-component, temperature–composition, solid–liquid diagram, one compound AB formed that melts congruently, negligible solid–solid solubility. 6.4 Draw phase diagrams for the following types of systems. Label the regions and intersections of the diagrams, stating what materials (possibly Further reading Articles and texts J.S. Alper, The Gibbs phase rule revisited: interrelationships between components and phases. J. Chem. Educ. 76, 1567 (1999). W.D. Callister, Jr., Materials science and engineering, an introduction. Wiley, New York (2000). P.J. Collings and M. Hird, Introduction to liquid crystals: chemistry and physics. Taylor & Francis, London (1997). M. Hillert, Phase equilibria, phase diagrams and phase transformations: a thermodynamic basis. Cambridge University Press (1998). H.-G. Lee, Chemical thermodynamics for metals and materials. Imperial College Press, London (1999). R.J. Stead and K. Stead, Phase diagrams for ternary liquid systems. J. Chem. Educ. 67, 385 (1990). S.I. Sandler, Chemical and engineering thermodynamics. Wiley, New York (1998). Sources of data and information A. Alper, Phase diagrams, Vols. 1, 2, and 3. Academic Press, New York (1970). J. Wisniak, Phase diagrams: a literature source book. Elsevier, Amsterdam (1981–86). 5. Thermal analysis is a technique for detecting phase transitions that takes advantage of the effect of the enthalpy change during a first-order transition. 6. The vapour pressure of an ideal solution is given by p = p*B + (p*A − p*B)xA. The composition of the vapour, yA = xAp*A/{p*B + (p*A − p*B)xA}, yB = 1 − yA. 7. The total vapour pressure of a mixture is given by p = pA*p*B/{p*A + (p*B − p*A)yA}. 8. An isopleth is a line of constant composition in a phase diagram. A tie line is a line joining two points representing phases in equilibrium. 9. The lever rule allows for the calculation of the relative amounts of two phases in equilibrium: nαlα = nβlβ. 10. A temperature–composition diagram is a phase diagram in which the boundaries show the composition of the phases that are in equilibrium at various temperatures. 11. An azeotrope is a mixture that boils without change of composition. 12. Partially miscible liquids are liquids that do not mix in all proportions at all temperatures. 13. The upper critical solution temperature is the highest temperature at which phase separation occurs in a binary liquid mixture. The lower critical solution temperature is the temperature below which the components of a binary mixture mix in all proportions and above which they form two phases. 14. A eutectic is the mixture with the lowest melting point; a liquid with the eutectic composition freezes at a single temperature. A eutectic halt is a delay in cooling while the eutectic freezes. 15. Incongruent melting occurs when a compound melts into its components and does not itself form a liquid phase. compounds or azeotropes) are present and whether they are solid liquid or gas. (a) Two-component, temperature–composition, solid–liquid diagram, one compound of formula AB2 that melts incongruently, negligible solid–solid solubility; (b) two-component, constant temperature– composition, liquid–vapour diagram, formation of an azeotrope at xB = 0.333, complete miscibility. 6.5 Label the regions of the phase diagram in Fig. 6.37. State what substances (if compounds give their formulas) exist in each region. Label each substance in each region as solid, liquid, or gas. 6.6 Label the regions of the phase diagram in Fig. 6.38. State what substances (if compounds give their formulas) exist in each region. Label each substance in each region as solid, liquid, or gas. EXERCISES 195 Exercises 6.1(a) At 90°C, the vapour pressure of methylbenzene is 53.3 kPa and that of 1,2-dimethylbenzene is 20.0 kPa. What is the composition of a liquid mixture that boils at 90°C when the pressure is 0.50 atm? What is the composition of the vapour produced? 6.1(b) At 90°C, the vapour pressure of 1,2-dimethylbenzene is 20 kPa and that of 1,3-dimethylbenzene is 18 kPa. What is the composition of a liquid mixture that boils at 90°C when the pressure is 19 kPa? What is the composition of the vapour produced? 6.2(a) The vapour pressure of pure liquid A at 300 K is 76.7 kPa and that of pure liquid B is 52.0 kPa. These two compounds form ideal liquid and gaseous mixtures. Consider the equilibrium composition of a mixture in which the mole fraction of A in the vapour is 0.350. Calculate the total pressure of the vapour and the composition of the liquid mixture. 6.2(b) The vapour pressure of pure liquid A at 293 K is 68.8 kPa and that of pure liquid B is 82.1 kPa. These two compounds form ideal liquid and gaseous mixtures. Consider the equilibrium composition of a mixture in which the mole fraction of A in the vapour is 0.612. Calculate the total pressure of the vapour and the composition of the liquid mixture. 6.3(a) It is found that the boiling point of a binary solution of A and B with xA = 0.6589 is 88°C. At this temperature the vapour pressures of pure A and B are 127.6 kPa and 50.60 kPa, respectively. (a) Is this solution ideal? (b) What is the initial composition of the vapour above the solution? 6.3(b) It is found that the boiling point of a binary solution of A and B with xA = 0.4217 is 96°C. At this temperature the vapour pressures of pure A and B are 110.1 kPa and 76.5 kPa, respectively. (a) Is this solution ideal? (b) What is the initial composition of the vapour above the solution? 6.4(a) Dibromoethene (DE, p*DE = 22.9 kPa at 358 K) and dibromopropene (DP, p*DP = 17.1 kPa at 358 K) form a nearly ideal solution. If zDE = 0.60, what is (a) ptotal when the system is all liquid, (b) the composition of the vapour when the system is still almost all liquid? 6.4(b) Benzene and toluene form nearly ideal solutions. Consider an equimolar solution of benzene and toluene. At 20°C the vapour pressures of pure benzene and toluene are 9.9 kPa and 2.9 kPa, respectively. The solution is boiled by reducing the external pressure below the vapour pressure. Calculate (a) the pressure when boiling begins, (b) the composition of each component in the vapour, and (c) the vapour pressure when only a few drops of liquid remain. Assume that the rate of vaporization is low enough for the temperature to remain constant at 20°C. 6.5(a) The following temperature/composition data were obtained for a mixture of octane (O) and methylbenzene (M) at 1.00 atm, where x is the mole fraction in the liquid and y the mole fraction in the vapour at equilibrium. θ/°C 110.9 112.0 114.0 115.8 117.3 119.0 121.1 123.0 xM 0.908 0.795 0.615 0.527 0.408 0.300 0.203 0.097 yM 0.923 0.836 0.698 0.624 0.527 0.410 0.297 0.164 The boiling points are 110.6°C and 125.6°C for M and O, respectively. Plot the temperature/composition diagram for the mixture. What is the composition of the vapour in equilibrium with the liquid of composition (a) xM = 0.250 and (b) xO = 0.250? 6.5(b) The following temperature/composition data were obtained for a mixture of two liquids A and B at 1.00 atm, where x is the mole fraction in the liquid and y the mole fraction in the vapour at equilibrium. θ/°C 125 130 135 140 145 150 xA 0.91 0.65 0.45 0.30 0.18 0.098 yA 0.99 0.91 0.77 0.61 0.45 0.25 The boiling points are 124°C for A and 155°C for B. Plot the temperature– composition diagram for the mixture. What is the composition of the vapour in equilibrium with the liquid of composition (a) xA = 0.50 and (b) xB = 0.33? 6.6(a) State the number of components in the following systems. (a) NaH2PO4 in water at equilibrium with water vapour but disregarding the fact that the salt is ionized. (b) The same, but taking into account the ionization of the salt. 6.6(b) State the number of components for a system in which AlCl3 is dissolved in water, noting that hydrolysis and precipitation of Al(OH)3 occur. 6.7(a) Blue CuSO4·5H2O crystals release their water of hydration when heated. How many phases and components are present in an otherwise empty heated container? 6.7(b) Ammonium chloride, NH4Cl, decomposes when it is heated. (a) How many components and phases are present when the salt is heated in an otherwise empty container? (b) Now suppose that additional ammonia is also present. How many components and phases are present? 6.8(a) A saturated solution of Na2SO4, with excess of the solid, is present at equilibrium with its vapour in a closed vessel. (a) How many phases and components are present. (b) What is the variance (the number of degrees of freedom) of the system? Identify the independent variables. 6.8(b) Suppose that the solution referred to in Exercise 6.8a is not saturated. (a) How many phases and components are present. (b) What is the variance (the number of degrees of freedom) of the system? Identify the independent variables. 0 1 xB 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 Temperature,T Fig. 6.37 0 1 xB 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 Temperature,T 0.33 0.67 Fig. 6.38 196 6 PHASE DIAGRAMS 6.9(a) Methylethyl ether (A) and diborane, B2H6 (B), form a compound that melts congruently at 133 K. The system exhibits two eutectics, one at 25 mol per cent B and 123 K and a second at 90 mol per cent B and 104 K. The melting points of pure A and B are 131 K and 110 K, respectively. Sketch the phase diagram for this system. Assume negligible solid–solid solubility. 6.9(b) Sketch the phase diagram of the system NH3/N2H4 given that the two substances do not form a compound with each other, that NH3 freezes at −78°C and N2H4 freezes at +2°C, and that a eutectic is formed when the mole fraction of N2H4 is 0.07 and that the eutectic melts at −80°C. 6.10(a) Figure 6.39 shows the phase diagram for two partially miscible liquids, which can be taken to be that for water (A) and 2-methyl-1-propanol (B). Describe what will be observed when a mixture of composition xB = 0.8 is heated, at each stage giving the number, composition, and relative amounts of the phases present. 6.10(b) Figure 6.40 is the phase diagram for silver and tin. Label the regions, and describe what will be observed when liquids of compositions a and b are cooled to 200 K. 6.11(a) Indicate on the phase diagram in Fig. 6.41 the feature that denotes incongruent melting. What is the composition of the eutectic mixture and at what temperature does it melt? 6.11(b) Indicate on the phase diagram in Fig. 6.42 the feature that denotes incongruent melting. What is the composition of the eutectic mixture and at what temperature does it melt? 6.12(a) Sketch the cooling curves for the isopleths a and b in Fig. 6.41. 6.12(b) Sketch the cooling curves for the isopleths a and b in Fig. 6.42. Fig. 6.40 0 100 Temperature,/°C 200 400 600 800 1000 Liquid ab AgSn3 20 40 60 80 Mass percentage Ag/% q Fig. 6.39 0 1 xB 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 Temperature,T T1 6.13(a) Use the phase diagram in Fig. 6.40 to state (a) the solubility of Ag in Sn at 800°C and (b) the solubility of Ag3Sn in Ag at 460°C, (c) the solubility of Ag3Sn in Ag at 300°C. 6.13(b) Use the phase diagram in Fig. 6.41 to state (a) the solubility of B in A at 500°C and (b) the solubility of AB2 in A at 390°C, (c) the solubility of AB2 in B at 300°C. 6.14(a) Figure 6.43 shows the experimentally determined phase diagrams for the nearly ideal solution of hexane and heptane. (a) Label the regions of the diagrams as to which phases are present. (b) For a solution containing 1 mol each of hexane and heptane, estimate the vapour pressure at 70°C when vaporization on reduction of the external pressure just begins. (c) What is the vapour pressure of the solution at 70°C when just one drop of liquid remains. (d) Estimate from the figures the mole fraction of hexane in the liquid and vapour phases for the conditions of part b. (e) What are the mole fractions for the conditions of part c? (f) At 85°C and 760 Torr, what are the amounts of substance in the liquid and vapour phases when zheptane = 0.40? 6.14(b) Uranium tetrafluoride and zirconium tetrafluoride melt at 1035°C and 912°C, respectively. They form a continuous series of solid solutions with a minimum melting temperature of 765°C and composition x(ZrF4) = 0.77. At 900°C, the liquid solution of composition x(ZrF4) = 0.28 is in equilibrium with a solid solution of composition x(ZrF4) = 0.14. At 850°C the two compositions are 0.87 and 0.90, respectively. Sketch the phase diagram for this system and state what is observed when a liquid of composition x(ZrF4) = 0.40 is cooled slowly from 900°C to 500°C. 6.15(a) Methane (melting point 91 K) and tetrafluoromethane (melting point 89 K) do not form solid solutions with each other, and as liquids they are only partially miscible. The upper critical temperature of the liquid mixture is 94 K at x(CF4) = 0.43 and the eutectic temperature is 84 K at x(CF4) = 0.88. At 86 K, the phase in equilibrium with the tetrafluoromethane-rich 0 1 Temperature,/°C 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 xB a b 300°C 400°C 500°C T1 T2 q Fig. 6.41 0 1 Temperature,T 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 xB ab T1 T2 T3 Fig. 6.42 PROBLEMS 197 * Problems denoted with the symbol ‡ were supplied by Charles Trapp, Carmen Giunta, and Marshall Cady. solution changes from solid methane to a methane-rich liquid. At that temperature, the two liquid solutions that are in mutual equilibrium have the compositions x(CF4) = 0.10 and x(CF4) = 0.80. Sketch the phase diagram. 6.15(b) Describe the phase changes that take place when a liquid mixture of 4.0 mol B2H6 (melting point 131 K) and 1.0 mol CH3OCH3 (melting point 135 K) is cooled from 140 K to 90 K. These substances form a compound (CH3)2OB2H6 that melts congruently at 133 K. The system exhibits one eutectic at x(B2H6) = 0.25 and 123 K and another at x(B2H6) = 0.90 and 104 K. 6.16(a) Refer to the information in Exercise 6.15(b) and sketch the cooling curves for liquid mixtures in which x(B2H6) is (a) 0.10, (b) 0.30, (c) 0.50, (d) 0.80, and (e) 0.95. 6.16(b) Refer to the information in Exercise 6.15(a) and sketch the cooling curves for liquid mixtures in which x(CF4) is (a) 0.10, (b) 0.30, (c) 0.50, (d) 0.80, and (e) 0.95. 6.17(a) Hexane and perfluorohexane show partial miscibility below 22.70°C. The critical concentration at the upper critical temperature is x = 0.355, where x is the mole fraction of C6F14. At 22.0°C the two solutions in equilibrium have x = 0.24 and x = 0.48, respectively, and at 21.5°C the mole fractions are 0.22 and 0.51. Sketch the phase diagram. Describe the phase changes that occur when perfluorohexane is added to a fixed amount of hexane at (a) 23°C, (b) 22°C. 6.17(b) Two liquids, A and B, show partial miscibility below 52.4°C. The critical concentration at the upper critical temperature is x = 0.459, where x is the mole fraction of A. At 40.0°C the two solutions in equilibrium have x = 0.22 and x = 0.60, respectively, and at 42.5°C the mole fractions are 0.24 and 0.48. Sketch the phase diagram. Describe the phase changes that occur when B is added to a fixed amount of A at (a) 48°C, (b) 52.4°C. 0 1 Pressure,/Torrp 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 zHeptane 300 500 700 900 70°C 0 10.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 zHeptane 760Torr Temperature,/°C 60 70 80 90 100 q Fig. 6.43 Problems* Numerical problems 6.1‡ 1-Butanol and chlorobenzene form a minimum-boiling azeotropic system. The mole fraction of 1-butanol in the liquid (x) and vapour (y) phases at 1.000 atm is given below for a variety of boiling temperatures (H. Artigas, C. Lafuente, P. Cea, F.M. Royo, and J.S. Urieta, J. Chem. Eng. Data 42, 132 (1997)). T/K 396.57 393.94 391.60 390.15 389.03 388.66 388.57 x 0.1065 0.1700 0.2646 0.3687 0.5017 0.6091 0.7171 y 0.2859 0.3691 0.4505 0.5138 0.5840 0.6409 0.7070 Pure chlorobenzene boils at 404.86 K. (a) Construct the chlorobenzene-rich portion of the phase diagram from the data. (b) Estimate the temperature at which a solution whose mole fraction of 1-butanol is 0.300 begins to boil. (c) State the compositions and relative proportions of the two phases present after a solution initially 0.300 1-butanol is heated to 393.94 K. 6.2‡ An et al. investigated the liquid–liquid coexistence curve of N,Ndimethylacetamide and heptane (X. An, H. Zhao, F. Fuguo, and W. Shen, J. Chem. Thermodynamics 28, 1221 (1996)). Mole fractions of N,Ndimethylacetamide in the upper (x1) and lower (x2) phases of a two-phase region are given below as a function of temperature: T/K 309.820 309.422 309.031 308.006 306.686 x1 0.473 0.400 0.371 0.326 0.293 x2 0.529 0.601 0.625 0.657 0.690 T/K 304.553 301.803 299.097 296.000 294.534 x1 0.255 0.218 0.193 0.168 0.157 x2 0.724 0.758 0.783 0.804 0.814 (a) Plot the phase diagram. (b) State the proportions and compositions of the two phases that form from mixing 0.750 mol of N,N-dimethylacetamide with 0.250 mol of heptane at 296.0 K. To what temperature must the mixture be heated to form a single-phase mixture? 6.3‡ The following data have been obtained for the liquid–vapour equilibrium compositions of mixtures of nitrogen and oxygen at 100 kPa. T/K 77.3 78 80 82 84 86 88 90.2 x(O2) 0 10 34 54 70 82 92 100 y(O2) 0 2 11 22 35 52 73 100 p*(O2)/Torr 154 171 225 294 377 479 601 760 Plot the data on a temperature–composition diagram and determine the extent to which it fits the predictions for an ideal solution by calculating the activity coefficients of O2 at each composition. 6.4 Phosphorus and sulfur form a series of binary compounds. The best characterized are P4S3, P4S7, and P4S10, all of which melt congruently. Assuming that only these three binary compounds of the two elements exist, (a) draw schematically only the P/S phase diagram. Label each region of the diagram with the substance that exists in that region and indicate its phase. Label the horizontal axis as xS and give the numerical values of xS that correspond to the compounds. The melting point of pure phosphorus is 44°C and that of pure sulfur is 119°C. (b) Draw, schematically, the cooling curve for a mixture of composition xS = 0.28. Assume that a eutectic occurs at xS = 0.2 and negligible solid–solid solubility. 6.5 The table below gives the break and halt temperatures found in the cooling curves of two metals A and B. Construct a phase diagram consistent 198 6 PHASE DIAGRAMS with the data of these curves. Label the regions of the diagram, stating what phases and substances are present. Give the probable formulas of any compounds that form. 100xB θbreak/°C θhalt,1/°C θhalt,2/°C 0 1100 10.0 1060 700 20.0 1000 700 30.0 940 700 400 40.0 850 700 400 50.0 750 700 400 60.0 670 400 70.0 550 400 80.0 400 90.0 450 400 100.0 500 6.6 Consider the phase diagram in Fig. 6.44, which represents a solid–liquid equilibrium. Label all regions of the diagram according to the chemical species that exist in that region and their phases. Indicate the number of species and phases present at the points labelled b, d, e, f, g, and k. Sketch cooling curves for compositions xB = 0.16, 0.23, 0.57, 0.67, and 0.84. atom composition Si melt is cooled to 1030°C. What phases, and relative amounts, would be at equilibrium at a temperature (i) slightly higher than 1030°C, (ii) slightly lower than 1030°C? Draw a graph of the mole percentages of both Si(s) and CaSi2(s) as a function of mole percentage of melt that is freezing at 1030°C. 6.10 Iron(II) chloride (melting point 677°C) and potassium chloride (melting point 776°C) form the compounds KFeCl3 and K2FeCl4 at elevated temperatures. KFeCl3 melts congruently at 380°C and K2FeCl4 melts incongruently at 399°C. Eutectics are formed with compositions x = 0.38 (melting point 351°C) and x = 0.54 (melting point 393°C), where x is the mole fraction of FeCl2. The KCl solubility curve intersects the K2FeCl4 curve at x = 0.34. Sketch the phase diagram. State the phases that are in equilibrium when a mixture of composition x = 0.36 is cooled from 400°Cto 300°C. Theoretical problems 6.11 Show that two phases are in thermal equilibrium only if their temperatures are the same. 6.12 Show that two phases are in mechanical equilibrium only if their pressures are equal. Applications: to biology, materials science, and chemical engineering 6.13 The unfolding, or denaturation, of a biological macromolecule may be brought about by treatment with substances, called denaturants, that disrupt the intermolecular interactions responsible for the native three-dimensional conformation of the polymer. For example, urea, CO(NH2)2, competes for NH and CO groups and interferes with hydrogen bonding in a polypeptide. Temperature,/°C 0 1 xB 700 900 1100 1300 1500 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 Liquid CaSi2 CaSi CaSi2 1030 0.694 1324 1040 1268 0.402 1314 792 0.056q Fig. 6.46 Temperature,T 0.16 0.23 0.57 0.67 0.84 b c d e f g k 0 1xB Fig. 6.44 0 1 xB 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 -4 -3 -2 -1 0 DmixG/(kJmol)1 1100 K 1300 K 1500 K Fig. 6.45 6.7 Sketch the phase diagram for the Mg/Cu system using the following information: θf(Mg) = 648°C, θf(Cu) = 1085°C; two intermetallic compounds are formed with θf(MgCu2) = 800°C and θf(Mg2Cu) = 580°C; eutectics of mass percentage Mg composition and melting points 10 per cent (690°C), 33 per cent (560°C), and 65 per cent (380°C). A sample of Mg/Cu alloy containing 25 per cent Mg by mass was prepared in a crucible heated to 800°C in an inert atmosphere. Describe what will be observed if the melt is cooled slowly to room temperature. Specify the composition and relative abundances of the phases and sketch the cooling curve. 6.8‡ Figure 6.45 shows ∆mixG(xPb, T) for a mixture of copper and lead. (a) What does the graph reveal about the miscibility of copper and lead and the spontaneity of solution formation? What is the variance (F) at (i) 1500 K, (ii) 1100 K? (b) Suppose that at 1500 K a mixture of composition (i) xPb = 0.1, (ii) xPb = 0.7, is slowly cooled to 1100 K. What is the equilibrium composition of the final mixture? Include an estimate of the relative amounts of each phase. (c) What is the solubility of (i) lead in copper, (ii) copper in lead at 1100 K? 6.9‡ The temperature–composition diagram for the Ca/Si binary system is shown in Fig. 6.46. (a) Identify eutectics, congruent melting compounds, and incongruent melting compounds. (b) If a 20 per cent by atom composition melt of silicon at 1500°C is cooled to 1000°C, what phases (and phase composition) would be at equilibrium? Estimate the relative amounts of each phase. (c) Describe the equilibrium phases observed when an 80 per cent by PROBLEMS 199 In a theoretical study of a protein, the temperature–composition diagram shown in Fig. 6.47 was obtained. It shows three structural regions: the native form, the unfolded form, and a ‘molten globule’ form, a partially unfolded but still compact form of the protein. (i) Is the molten globule form ever stable when the denaturant concentration is below 0.1? (ii) Describe what happens to the polymer as the native form is heated in the presence of denaturant at concentration 0.15. 6.14 The basic structural element of a membrane is a phospholipid, such as phosphatidyl choline, which contains long hydrocarbon chains (typically in the range C14–C24) and a variety of polar groups, such as –CH2CH2N(CH3)3 + . The hydrophobic chains stack together to form an extensive bilayer about 5 nm across, leaving the polar groups exposed to the aqueous environment on either side of the membrane (see Chapter 19 for details). All lipid bilayers undergo a transition from a state of low chain mobility (the gel form) to high chain mobility (the liquid crystal form) at a temperature that depends on the structure of the lipid. Biological cell membranes exist as liquid crystals at physiological temperatures. In an experimental study of membrane-like assemblies, a phase diagram like that shown in Fig. 6.48 was obtained. The two components are dielaidoylphosphatidylcholine (DEL) and dipalmitoylphosphatidylcholine (DPL). Explain what happens as a liquid mixture of composition xDEL = 0.5 is cooled from 45°C. crystal phase will make a transition to a normal liquid phase at a definite temperature. 6.16 Some polymers can form liquid crystal mesophases with unusual physical properties. For example, liquid crystalline Kevlar (3) is strong enough to be the material of choice for bulletproof vests and is stable at temperatures up to 600 K. What molecular interactions contribute to the formation, thermal stability, and mechanical strength of liquid crystal mesophases in Kevlar? 0 0.1 0.2 0.3 Denaturant 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9 1 Temperature Unfolded Native Molten- globule Fig. 6.47 0 1Composition, xDPL Temperature,/°C 10 20 30 40 Fluid Solid Fluid solid+ q Fig. 6.48 6.15 The compound p-azoxyanisole forms a liquid crystal. 5.0 g of the solid was placed in a tube, which was then evacuated and sealed. Use the phase rule to prove that the solid will melt at a definite temperature and that the liquid 6.17 Use a phase diagram like that shown in Fig. 6.36 to indicate how zone levelling may be described. 6.18 The technique of float zoning, which is similar to zone refining (Impact I6.2), has produced very pure samples of silicon for use in the semiconductor industry. Consult a textbook of materials science or metallurgy and prepare a discussion of the principles, advantages, and disadvantages of float zoning. 6.19 Magnesium oxide and nickel oxide withstand high temperatures. However, they do melt when the temperature is high enough and the behaviour of mixtures of the two is of considerable interest to the ceramics industry. Draw the temperature–composition diagram for the system using the data below, where x is the mole fraction of MgO in the solid and y its mole fraction in the liquid. θ/°C 1960 2200 2400 2600 2800 x 0 0.35 0.60 0.83 1.00 y 0 0.18 0.38 0.65 1.00 State (a) the melting point of a mixture with x = 0.30, (b) the composition and proportion of the phases present when a solid of composition x = 0.30 is heated to 2200°C, (c) the temperature at which a liquid of composition y = 0.70 will begin to solidify. 6.20 The bismuth–cadmium phase diagram is of interest in metallurgy, and its general form can be estimated from expressions for the depression of freezing point. Construct the diagram using the following data: Tf(Bi) = 544.5 K, Tf(Cd) = 594 K, ∆fusH(Bi) = 10.88 kJ mol−1 , ∆fusH(Cd) = 6.07 kJ mol−1 . The metals are mutually insoluble as solids. Use the phase diagram to state what would be observed when a liquid of composition x(Bi) = 0.70 is cooled slowly from 550 K. What are the relative abundances of the liquid and solid at (a) 460 K and (b) 350 K? Sketch the cooling curve for the mixture. 6.21‡ Carbon dioxide at high pressure is used to separate various compounds in citrus oil. The mole fraction of CO2 in the liquid (x) and vapour (y) at 323.2 K is given below for a variety of pressures (Y. Iwai, T. Morotomi, K. Sakamoto, Y. Koga, and Y. Arai, J. Chem. Eng. Data 41, 951 (1996)). p/MPa 3.94 6.02 7.97 8.94 9.27 x 0.2873 0.4541 0.6650 0.7744 0.8338 y 0.9982 0.9980 0.9973 0.9958 0.9922 (a) Plot the portion of the phase diagram represented by these data. (b) State the compositions and relative proportions of the two phases present after an equimolar gas mixture is compressed to 6.02 MPa at 323.2 K. 3 Chemical equilibrium This chapter develops the concept of chemical potential and shows how it is used to account for the equilibrium composition of chemical reactions. The equilibrium composition corresponds to a minimum in the Gibbs energy plotted against the extent of reaction, and by locating this minimum we establish the relation between the equilibrium constant and the standard Gibbs energy of reaction. The thermodynamic formulation of equilibrium enables us to establish the quantitative effects of changes in the conditions. The principles of thermodynamics established in the preceding chapters can be applied to the description of the thermodynamic properties of reactions that take place in electrochemical cells, in which, as the reaction proceeds, it drives electrons through an external circuit. Thermodynamic arguments can be used to derive an expression for the electric potential of such cells and the potential can be related to their composition. There are two major topics developed in this connection. One is the definition and tabulation of standard potentials; the second is the use of these standard potentials to predict the equilibrium constants and other thermodynamic properties of chemical reactions. Chemical reactions tend to move towards a dynamic equilibrium in which both reactants and products are present but have no further tendency to undergo net change. In some cases, the concentration of products in the equilibrium mixture is so much greater than that of the unchanged reactants that for all practical purposes the reaction is ‘complete’. However, in many important cases the equilibrium mixture has significant concentrations of both reactants and products. In this chapter we see how to use thermodynamics to predict the equilibrium composition under any reaction conditions. Because many reactions of ions involve the transfer of electrons, they can be studied (and utilized) by allowing them to take place in an electrochemical cell. Measurements like those described in this chapter provide data that are very useful for discussing the characteristics of electrolyte solutions and of ionic equilibria in solution. Spontaneous chemical reactions We have seen that the direction of spontaneous change at constant temperature and pressure is towards lower values of the Gibbs energy, G. The idea is entirely general, and in this chapter we apply it to the discussion of chemical reactions. 7.1 The Gibbs energy minimum We locate the equilibrium composition of a reaction mixture by calculating the Gibbs energy of the reaction mixture and identifying the composition that corresponds to minimum G. Spontaneous chemical reactions 7.1 The Gibbs energy minimum 7.2 The description of equilibrium The response of equilibria to the conditions 7.3 How equilibria respond to pressure 7.4 The response of equilibria to temperature I7.1 Impact on engineering: The extraction of metals from their oxides Equilibrium electrochemistry 7.5 Half-reactions and electrodes 7.6 Varieties of cells 7.7 The electromotive force 7.8 Standard potentials 7.9 Applications of standard potentials I7.2 Impact on biochemistry: Energy conversion in biological cells Checklist of key ideas Further reading Discussion questions Exercises Problems 7 7.1 THE GIBBS ENERGY MINIMUM 201 (a) The reaction Gibbs energy Consider the equilibrium A 5 B. Even though this reaction looks trivial, there are many examples of it, such as the isomerization of pentane to 2-methylbutane and the conversion of l-alanine to d-alanine. Suppose an infinitesimal amount dξ of A turns into B, then the change in the amount of A present is dnA = −dξ and the change in the amount of B present is dnB = +dξ. The quantity ξ (xi) is called the extent of reaction; it has the dimensions of amount of substance and is reported in moles. When the extent of reaction changes by a finite amount ∆ξ, the amount of A present changes from nA,0 to nA,0 − ∆ξ and the amount of B changes from nB,0 to nB,0 + ∆ξ. So, if initially 2.0 mol A is present and we wait until ∆ξ = +1.5 mol, then the amount of A remaining will be 0.5 mol. The reaction Gibbs energy, ∆rG, is defined as the slope of the graph of the Gibbs energy plotted against the extent of reaction: ∆rG = p,T [7.1] Although ∆ normally signifies a difference in values, here ∆r signifies a derivative, the slope of G with respect to ξ. However, to see that there is a close relationship with the normal usage, suppose the reaction advances by dξ. The corresponding change in Gibbs energy is dG = µAdnA + µBdnB = −µAdξ + µBdξ = (µB − µA)dξ This equation can be reorganized into p,T = µB − µA That is, ∆rG = µB − µA (7.2) We see that ∆rG can also be interpreted as the difference between the chemical potentials (the partial molar Gibbs energies) of the reactants and products at the composition of the reaction mixture. Because chemical potential varies with composition, the slope of the plot of Gibbs energy against extent of reaction changes as the reaction proceeds. Moreover, because the reaction runs in the direction of decreasing G (that is, down the slope of G plotted against ξ), we see from eqn 7.2 that the reaction A → B is spontaneous when µA > µB, whereas the reverse reaction is spontaneous when µB > µA. The slope is zero, and the reaction is spontaneous in neither direction, when ∆rG = 0 (7.3) This condition occurs when µB = µA (Fig. 7.1). It follows that, if we can find the composition of the reaction mixture that ensures µB = µA, then we can identify the composition of the reaction mixture at equilibrium. (b) Exergonic and endergonic reactions We can express the spontaneity of a reaction at constant temperature and pressure in terms of the reaction Gibbs energy: If ∆rG < 0, the forward reaction is spontaneous. If ∆rG > 0, the reverse reaction is spontaneous. If ∆rG = 0, the reaction is at equilibrium. D F ∂G ∂ξ A C D F ∂G ∂ξ A C Fig. 7.1 As the reaction advances (represented by motion from left to right along the horizontal axis) the slope of the Gibbs energy changes. Equilibrium corresponds to zero slope, at the foot of the valley. 202 7 CHEMICAL EQUILIBRIUM A reaction for which ∆rG < 0 is called exergonic (from the Greek words for work producing). The name signifies that, because the process is spontaneous, it can be used to drive another process, such as another reaction, or used to do non-expansion work. A simple mechanical analogy is a pair of weights joined by a string (Fig. 7.2): the lighter of the pair of weights will be pulled up as the heavier weight falls down. Although the lighter weight has a natural tendency to move downward, its coupling to the heavier weight results in it being raised. In biological cells, the oxidation of carbohydrates act as the heavy weight that drives other reactions forward and results in the formation of proteins from amino acids, muscle contraction, and brain activity. A reaction for which ∆rG > 0 is called endergonic (signifying work consuming). The reaction can be made to occur only by doing work on it, such as electrolysing water to reverse its spontaneous formation reaction. Reactions at equilibrium are spontaneous in neither direction: they are neither exergonic nor endergonic. 7.2 The description of equilibrium With the background established, we are now ready to see how to apply thermodynamics to the description of chemical equilibrium. (a) Perfect gas equilibria When A and B are perfect gases we can use eqn 5.14 (µ = µ7 + RT ln p, with p interpreted as p/p7 ) to write ∆rG = µB − µA = (µB 7 + RT ln pB) − (µA 7 + RT ln pA) = ∆rG7 + RT ln (7.4)° If we denote the ratio of partial pressures by Q, we obtain ∆rG = ∆rG7 + RT ln Q Q = (7.5)° The ratio Q is an example of a reaction quotient. It ranges from 0 when pB = 0 (corresponding to pure A) to infinity when pA = 0 (corresponding to pure B). The standard reaction Gibbs energy, ∆rG7 , is defined (like the standard reaction enthalpy) as the difference in the standard molar Gibbs energies of the reactants and products. For our reaction ∆rG7 = G7 B,m − G7 A,m = µB 7 − µA 7 (7.6) In Section 3.6 we saw that the difference in standard molar Gibbs energies of the products and reactants is equal to the difference in their standard Gibbs energies of formation, so in practice we calculate ∆rG7 from ∆rG7 = ∆fG7 (B) − ∆fG7 (A) (7.7) At equilibrium ∆rG = 0. The ratio of partial pressures at equilibrium is denoted K, and eqn 7.5 becomes 0 = ∆rG7 + RT ln K This expression rearranges to RT ln K = −∆rG7 K = equilibrium (7.8)° D F pB pA A C pB pA pB pA Fig. 7.2 If two weights are coupled as shown here, then the heavier weight will move the lighter weight in its non-spontaneous direction: overall, the process is still spontaneous. The weights are the analogues of two chemical reactions: a reaction with a large negative ∆G can force another reaction with a less ∆G to run in its non-spontaneous direction. Comment 7.1 Note that in the definition of ∆rG7 , the ∆r has its normal meaning as a difference whereas in the definition of ∆rG the ∆r signifies a derivative. 7.2 THE DESCRIPTION OF EQUILIBRIUM 203 Gibbsenergy,G Extent of reaction, 0 Without mixing Including mixing Mixing x Fig. 7.3 If the mixing of reactants and products is ignored, then the Gibbs energy changes linearly from its initial value (pure reactants) to its final value (pure products) and the slope of the line is ∆rG7 . However, as products are produced, there is a further contribution to the Gibbs energy arising from their mixing (lowest curve). The sum of the two contributions has a minimum. That minimum corresponds to the equilibrium composition of the system. This relation is a special case of one of the most important equations in chemical thermodynamics: it is the link between tables of thermodynamic data, such as those in the Data section at the end of this volume, and the chemically important equilibrium constant, K. Molecular interpretation 7.1 The approach to equilibrium In molecular terms, the minimum in the Gibbs energy, which corresponds to ∆rG = 0, stems from the Gibbs energy of mixing of the two gases. Hence, an important contribution to the position of chemical equilibrium is the mixing of the products with the reactants as the products are formed. Consider a hypothetical reaction in which A molecules change into B molecules without mingling together. The Gibbs energy of the system changes from G7 (A) to G7 (B) in proportion to the amount of B that had been formed, and the slope of the plot of G against the extent of reaction is a constant and equal to ∆rG7 at all stages of the reaction (Fig. 7.3). There is no intermediate minimum in the graph. However, in fact, the newly produced B molecules do mix with the surviving A molecules. We have seen that the contribution of a mixing process to the change in Gibbs energy is given by eqn 5.27 (∆mixG = nRT(xA ln xA + xB ln xB)). This expression makes a U-shaped contribution to the total change in Gibbs energy. As can be seen from Fig. 7.3, there is now an intermediate minimum in the Gibbs energy, and its position corresponds to the equilibrium composition of the reaction mixture. We see from eqn 7.8 that, when ∆rG7 > 0, the equilibrium constant K < 1. Therefore, at equilibrium the partial pressure of A exceeds that of B, which means that the reactant A is favoured in the equilibrium. When ∆rG7 < 0, the equilibrium constant K > 1, so at equilibrium the partial pressure of B exceeds that of A. Now the product B is favoured in the equilibrium. (b) The general case of a reaction We can easily extend the argument that led to eqn 7.8 to a general reaction. First, we need to generalize the concept of extent of reaction. Consider the reaction 2 A + B → 3 C + D. A more sophisticated way of expressing the chemical equation is to write it in the symbolic form 0 = 3 C + D − 2 A − B by subtracting the reactants from both sides (and replacing the arrow by an equals sign). This equation has the form 0 = ∑ J νJJ (7.9) where J denotes the substances and the νJ are the corresponding stoichiometric numbers in the chemical equation. In our example, these numbers have the values νA = −2, νB = −1, νC = +3, and νD = +1. A stoichiometric number is positive for products and negative for reactants. Then we define ξ so that, if it changes by ∆ξ, then the change in the amount of any species J is νJ∆ξ. Illustration 7.1 Identifying stoichiometric numbers To express the equation N2(g) + 3 H2(g) → 2 NH3(g) (7.10) 204 7 CHEMICAL EQUILIBRIUM in the notation of eqn 7.9, we rearrange it to 0 = 2 NH3(g) − N2(g) + 3 H2(g) and then identify the stoichiometric numbers as νN2 = −1, νH2 = −3, and νNH3 = +2. Therefore, if initially there is 10 mol N2 present, then when the extent of reaction changes from ξ = 0 to ξ = 1 mol, implying that ∆ξ = +1 mol, the amount of N2 changes from 10 mol to 9 mol. All the N2 has been consumed when ξ = 10 mol. When ∆ξ = +1 mol, the amount of H2 changes by −3 × (1 mol) = −3 mol and the amount of NH3 changes by +2 × (1 mol) = +2 mol. A note on good practice Stoichiometric numbers may be positive or negative; stoichiometric coefficients are always positive. Few, however, make the distinction between the two types of quantity. The reaction Gibbs energy, ∆rG, is defined in the same way as before, eqn 7.1. In the Justification below, we show that the Gibbs energy of reaction can always be written ∆rG = ∆rG7 + RT ln Q (7.11) with the standard reaction Gibbs energy calculated from ∆rG7 = ∑ Products ν∆fG7 − ∑ Reactants ν∆fG7 (7.12a) or, more formally, ∆rG7 = ∑ J νJ∆fG7 (J) (7.12b) The reaction quotient, Q, has the form Q = (7.13a) with each species raised to the power given by its stoichiometric coefficient. More formally, to write the general expression for Q we introduce the symbol Π to denote the product of what follows it (just as ∑ denotes the sum), and define Q as Q = ΠJ aJ νJ [7.13b] Because reactants have negative stoichiometric numbers, they automatically appear as the denominator when the product is written out explicitly. Recall from Table 5.3 that, for pure solids and liquids, the activity is 1, so such substances make no contribution to Q even though they may appear in the chemical equation. Illustration 7.2 Writing a reaction quotient Consider the reaction 2 A + 3 B → C + 2 D, in which case νA = −2, νB = −3, νC = +1, and νD = +2. The reaction quotient is then Q = aA −2 aB −3 aCa2 D = aCa2 D a2 Aa3 B activities of products activities of reactants 7.2 THE DESCRIPTION OF EQUILIBRIUM 205 Justification 7.1 The dependence of the reaction Gibbs energy on the reaction quotient Consider the reaction with stoichiometric numbers νJ. When the reaction advances by dξ, the amounts of reactants and products change by dnJ = νJdξ. The resulting infinitesimal change in the Gibbs energy at constant temperature and pressure is dG = ∑ J µJdnJ = ∑ J µJνJdξ = ∑ J νJµJ dξ (7.14) It follows that ∆rG = p,T = ∑ J νJµJ (7.15) To make further progress, we note that the chemical potential of a species J is related to its activity by eqn 5.25 (µJ = µJ 7 + RT ln aJ). When this expression is substituted into eqn 7.15 we obtain ∆rG7 ∆rG = ∑ J νJµJ 7 + RT ∑ J νJ ln aJ Q = ∆rG7 + RT ∑ J ln aJ νJ = ∆rG7 + RT ln ΠJ aJ νJ = ∆rG7 + RT ln Q with Q given by eqn 7.13b. Now we conclude the argument based on eqn 7.11. At equilibrium, the slope of G is zero: ∆rG = 0. The activities then have their equilibrium values and we can write K = ΠJ aJ νJ equilibrium [7.16] This expression has the same form as Q, eqn 7.13, but is evaluated using equilibrium activities. From now on, we shall not write the ‘equilibrium’ subscript explicitly, and will rely on the context to make it clear that for K we use equilibrium values and for Q we use the values at the specified stage of the reaction. An equilibrium constant K expressed in terms of activities (or fugacities) is called a thermodynamic equilibrium constant. Note that, because activities are dimensionless numbers, the thermodynamic equilibrium constant is also dimensionless. In elementary applications, the activities that occur in eqn 7.16 are often replaced by the numerical values of molalities (that is, by replacing aJ by bJ/b7 , where b7 = 1 mol kg−1 ), molar concentrations (that is, as [J]/c7 , where c7 = 1 mol dm−3 ), or the numerical values of partial pressures (that is, by pJ/p7 , where p7 = 1 bar). In such cases, the resulting expressions are only approximations. The approximation is particularly severe for electrolyte solutions, for in them activity coefficients differ from 1 even in very dilute solutions (Section 5.9). D F A C @ $ 5 6 7 D E F ∂G ∂ξ A B C D E F A B C Comment 7.2 Recall that a ln x = ln xa and ln x + ln y + · · · = ln xy · · · , so ∑ i ln xi = ln Πi xi . D E F A B C 206 7 CHEMICAL EQUILIBRIUM Comment 7.3 In Chapter 17 we shall see that the righthand side of eqn 7.17 may be expressed in terms of spectroscopic data for gasphase species; so this expression also provides a link between spectroscopy and equilibrium composition. Illustration 7.3 Writing an equilibrium constant. The equilibrium constant for the heterogeneous equilibrium CaCO3(s) 5 CaO(s) + CO2(g) is 1 K = a−1 CaCO3(s)aCaO(s)aCO2(g) = = aCO2 1 (Table 5.3). Provided the carbon dioxide can be treated as a perfect gas, we can go on to write K ≈ pCO2 /p7 and conclude that in this case the equilibrium constant is the numerical value of the decomposition vapour pressure of calcium carbonate. At this point we set ∆rG = 0 in eqn 7.11 and replace Q by K. We immediately obtain RT ln K = −∆rG7 (7.17) This is an exact and highly important thermodynamic relation, for it enables us to predict the equilibrium constant of any reaction from tables of thermodynamic data, and hence to predict the equilibrium composition of the reaction mixture. Example 7.1 Calculating an equilibrium constant Calculate the equilibrium constant for the ammonia synthesis reaction, eqn 7.10, at 298 K and show how K is related to the partial pressures of the species at equilibrium when the overall pressure is low enough for the gases to be treated as perfect. Method Calculate the standard reaction Gibbs energy from eqn 7.12 and convert it to the value of the equilibrium constant by using eqn 7.17. The expression for the equilibrium constant is obtained from eqn 7.16, and because the gases are taken to be perfect, we replace each activity by the ratio p/p7 , where p is a partial pressure. Answer The standard Gibbs energy of the reaction is ∆rG7 = 2∆fG7 (NH3, g) − {∆fG7 (N2, g) + 3∆fG7 (H2, g)} = 2∆fG7 (NH3, g) = 2 × (−16.5 kJ mol−1 ) Then, ln K = − = Hence, K = 6.1 × 105 . This result is thermodynamically exact. The thermodynamic equilibrium constant for the reaction is K = a2 NH3 aN2 a3 H2 2 × 16.5 × 103 8.3145 × 298 2 × (−16.5 × 103 J mol−1 ) (8.3145 J K−1 mol−1 ) × (298 K) 1 2 3 aCaO(s)aCO2(g) aCaCO3(s) 5 6 7 7.2 THE DESCRIPTION OF EQUILIBRIUM 207 and this ratio has exactly the value we have just calculated. At low overall pressures, the activities can be replaced by the ratios p/p7 , where p is a partial pressure, and an approximate form of the equilibrium constant is K = = Self-test 7.1 Evaluate the equilibrium constant for N2O4(g) 5 2 NO2(g) at 298 K. [K = 0.15] Example 7.2 Estimating the degree of dissociation at equilibrium The degree of dissociation, α, is defined as the fraction of reactant that has decomposed; if the initial amount of reactant is n and the amount at equilibrium is neq, then α = (n − neq)/n. The standard Gibbs energy of reaction for the decomposition H2O(g) → H2(g) + 1 –2 O2(g) is +118.08 kJ mol−1 at 2300 K. What is the degree of dissociation of H2O at 2300 K and 1.00 bar? Method The equilibrium constant is obtained from the standard Gibbs energy of reaction by using eqn 7.17, so the task is to relate the degree of dissociation, α, to K and then to find its numerical value. Proceed by expressing the equilibrium compositions in terms of α, and solve for α in terms of K. Because the standard Gibbs energy of reaction is large and positive, we can anticipate that K will be small, and hence that α << 1, which opens the way to making approximations to obtain its numerical value. Answer The equilibrium constant is obtained from eqn 7.17 in the form ln K = − = − = − It follows that K = 2.08 × 10−3 . The equilibrium composition can be expressed in terms of α by drawing up the following table: H2O H2 O2 Initial amount n 0 0 Change to reach equilibrium −αn +αn +1 –2αn Amount at equilibrium (1 − α)n αn 1 –2αn Total: (1 + 1 –2α)n Mole fraction, xJ Partial pressure, pJ where, for the entries in the last row, we have used pJ = xJp (eqn 1.13). The equilibrium constant is therefore K = = α3/2 p1/2 (1 − α)(2 + α)1/2 pH2 p1/2 O2 pH2O 1 –2αp 1 + 1 –2α αp 1 + 1 –2α (1 − α)p 1 + 1 –2α 1 –2α 1 + 1 –2α α 1 + 1 –2α 1 − α 1 + 1 –2α 118.08 × 103 8.3145 × 2300 (+118.08 × 103 J mol−1 ) (8.3145 J K−1 mol−1 ) × (2300 K) ∆rG7 RT p2 NH3 p72 pN2 p3 H2 (pNH3 /p7 )2 (pN2 /p7 )(pH2 /p7 )3 208 7 CHEMICAL EQUILIBRIUM Comment 7.4 The textbook’s web site contains links to online tools for the estimation of equilibrium constants of gas-phase reactions. Boltzmann distribution A B Population Energy Fig. 7.4 The Boltzmann distribution of populations over the energy levels of two species A and B with similar densities of energy levels; the reaction A → B is endothermic in this example. The bulk of the population is associated with the species A, so that species is dominant at equilibrium. In this expression, we have written p in place of p/p7 , to keep the notation simple. Now make the approximation that α << 1, and hence obtain K ≈ Under the stated condition, p = 1.00 bar (that is, p/p7 = 1.00), so α ≈ (21/2 K)2/3 = 0.0205. That is, about 2 per cent of the water has decomposed. A note on good practice Always check that the approximation is consistent with the final answer. In this case α << 1 in accord with the original assumption. Self-test 7.2 Given that the standard Gibbs energy of reaction at 2000 K is +135.2 kJ mol−1 for the same reaction, suppose that steam at 200 kPa is passed through a furnace tube at that temperature. Calculate the mole fraction of O2 present in the output gas stream. [0.00221] (c) The relation between equilibrium constants The only remaining problem is to express the thermodynamic equilibrium constant in terms of the mole fractions, xJ, or molalities, bJ, of the species. To do so, we need to know the activity coefficients, and then to use aJ = γJxJ or aJ = γJbJ/b7 (recalling that the activity coefficients depend on the choice). For example, in the latter case, for an equilibrium of the form A + B 5 C + D, where all four species are solutes, we write K = = × = Kγ Kb (7.18) The activity coefficients must be evaluated at the equilibrium composition of the mixture (for instance, by using one of the Debye–Hückel expressions, Section 5.9), which may involve a complicated calculation, because the activity coefficients are known only if the equilibrium composition is already known. In elementary applications, and to begin the iterative calculation of the concentrations in a real example, the assumption is often made that the activity coefficients are all so close to unity that Kγ = 1. Then we obtain the result widely used in elementary chemistry that K ≈ Kb, and equilibria are discussed in terms of molalities (or molar concentrations) themselves. Molecular interpretation 7.2 The molecular origin of the equilibrium constant We can obtain a deeper insight into the origin and significance of the equilibrium constant by considering the Boltzmann distribution of molecules over the available states of a system composed of reactants and products (recall Molecular interpretation 3.1). When atoms can exchange partners, as in a reaction, the available states of the system include arrangements in which the atoms are present in the form of reactants and in the form of products: these arrangements have their characteristic sets of energy levels, but the Boltzmann distribution does not distinguish between their identities, only their energies. The atoms distribute themselves over both sets of energy levels in accord with the Boltzmann distribution (Fig. 7.4). At a given temperature, there will be a specific distribution of populations, and hence a specific composition of the reaction mixture. It can be appreciated from the illustration that, if the reactants and products both have similar arrays of molecular energy levels, then the dominant species in a reaction mixture at equilibrium will be the species with the lower set of energy bCbD bAbB γCγD γAγB aCaD aAaB α3/2 p1/2 21/2 7.2 THE DESCRIPTION OF EQUILIBRIUM 209 Boltzmann distribution A B Population Energy Fig. 7.5 Even though the reaction A → B is endothermic, the density of energy levels in B is so much greater than that in A that the population associated with B is greater than that associated with A, so B is dominant at equilibrium. levels. However, the fact that the Gibbs energy occurs in the expression is a signal that entropy plays a role as well as energy. Its role can be appreciated by referring to Fig. 7.5. We see that, although the B energy levels lie higher than the A energy levels, in this instance they are much more closely spaced. As a result, their total population may be considerable and B could even dominate in the reaction mixture at equilibrium. Closely spaced energy levels correlate with a high entropy (see Molecular interpretation 3.1), so in this case we see that entropy effects dominate adverse energy effects. This competition is mirrored in eqn 7.17, as can be seen most clearly by using ∆rG7 = ∆rH7 − T∆rS7 and writing it in the form K = e−∆rH7 /RT e∆rS7 /R (7.19) Note that a positive reaction enthalpy results in a lowering of the equilibrium constant (that is, an endothermic reaction can be expected to have an equilibrium composition that favours the reactants). However, if there is positive reaction entropy, then the equilibrium composition may favour products, despite the endothermic character of the reaction. (d) Equilibria in biological systems We saw in Section 5.7 that for biological systems it is appropriate to adopt the biological standard state, in which aH+ = 10−7 and pH = −log aH+ = 7. It follows from eqn 5.56 that the relation between the thermodynamic and biological standard Gibbs energies of reaction for a reaction of the form A + νH+ (aq) → P (7.20a) is ∆rG⊕ = ∆rG7 + 7νRT ln 10 (7.20b) Note that there is no difference between the two standard values if hydrogen ions are not involved in the reaction (ν = 0). Illustration 7.4 Using the biological standard state Consider the reaction NADH(aq) + H+ (aq) → NAD+ (aq) + H2(g) at 37°C, for which ∆rG7 = −21.8 kJ mol−1 . NADH is the reduced form of nicotinamide adenine dinucleotide and NAD+ is its oxidized form; the molecules play an important role in the later stages of the respiratory process. It follows that, because ν = 1 and 7 ln10 = 16.1, ∆rG⊕ = −21.8 kJ mol−1 + 16.1 × (8.3145 × 10−3 kJ K−1 mol−1 ) × (310 K) = +19.7 kJ mol−1 Note that the biological standard value is opposite in sign (in this example) to the thermodynamic standard value: the much lower concentration of hydronium ions (by seven orders of magnitude) at pH = 7 in place of pH = 0, has resulted in the reverse reaction becoming spontaneous. Self-test 7.3 For a particular reaction of the form A → B + 2 H+ in aqueous solution, it was found that ∆rG7 = +20 kJ mol−1 at 28°C. Estimate the value of ∆rG⊕ . [−61 kJ mol−1 ] 210 7 CHEMICAL EQUILIBRIUM The response of equilibria to the conditions Equilibria respond to changes in pressure, temperature, and concentrations of reactants and products. The equilibrium constant for a reaction is not affected by the presence of a catalyst or an enzyme (a biological catalyst). As we shall see in detail in Sections 22.* and 24.*, catalysts increase the rate at which equilibrium is attained but do not affect its position. However, it is important to note that in industry reactions rarely reach equilibrium, partly on account of the rates at which reactants mix. 7.3 How equilibria respond to pressure The equilibrium constant depends on the value of ∆rG7 , which is defined at a single, standard pressure. The value of ∆rG7 , and hence of K, is therefore independent of the pressure at which the equilibrium is actually established. Formally we may express this independence as T = 0 (7.21) The conclusion that K is independent of pressure does not necessarily mean that the equilibrium composition is independent of the pressure, and its effect depends on how the pressure is applied. The pressure within a reaction vessel can be increased by injecting an inert gas into it. However, so long as the gases are perfect, this addition of gas leaves all the partial pressures of the reacting gases unchanged: the partial pressures of a perfect gas is the pressure it would exert if it were alone in the container, so the presence of another gas has no effect. It follows that pressurization by the addition of an inert gas has no effect on the equilibrium composition of the system (provided the gases are perfect). Alternatively, the pressure of the system may be increased by confining the gases to a smaller volume (that is, by compression). Now the individual partial pressures are changed but their ratio (as it appears in the equilibrium constant) remains the same. Consider, for instance, the perfect gas equilibrium A 5 2 B, for which the equilibrium constant is K = The right-hand side of this expression remains constant only if an increase in pA cancels an increase in the square of pB. This relatively steep increase of pA compared to pB will occur if the equilibrium composition shifts in favour of A at the expense of B. Then the number of A molecules will increase as the volume of the container is decreased and its partial pressure will rise more rapidly than can be ascribed to a simple change in volume alone (Fig. 7.6). The increase in the number of A molecules and the corresponding decrease in the number of B molecules in the equilibrium A 5 2 B is a special case of a principle proposed by the French chemist Henri Le Chatelier.1 Le Chatelier’s principle states that: A system at equilibrium, when subjected to a disturbance, responds in a way that tends to minimize the effect of the disturbance The principle implies that, if a system at equilibrium is compressed, then the reaction will adjust so as to minimize the increase in pressure. This it can do by reducing the number of particles in the gas phase, which implies a shift A ← 2 B. p2 B pAp7 D F ∂K ∂p A C (a) (b) Fig. 7.6 When a reaction at equilibrium is compressed (from a to b), the reaction responds by reducing the number of molecules in the gas phase (in this case by producing the dimers represented by the linked spheres). 1 Le Chatelier also invented oxyacetylene welding. 7.4 THE RESPONSE OF EQUILIBRIA TO TEMPERATURE 211 0 4 8 12 16 0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 Extentofdissociation, 0.1 1.0 10 100 p p/ Æ a Fig. 7.7 The pressure dependence of the degree of dissociation, α, at equilibrium for an A(g) 5 2 B(g) reaction for different values of the equilibrium constant K. The value α = 0 corresponds to pure A; α = 1 corresponds to pure B. Exploration Plot xA and xB against the pressure p for several values of the equilibrium constant K. To treat the effect of compression quantitatively, we suppose that there is an amount n of A present initially (and no B). At equilibrium the amount of A is (1 − α)n and the amount of B is 2αn, where α is the extent of dissociation of A into 2B. It follows that the mole fractions present at equilibrium are xA = = xB = The equilibrium constant for the reaction is K = = = which rearranges to α = 1/2 (7.22) This formula shows that, even though K is independent of pressure, the amounts of A and B do depend on pressure (Fig. 7.7). It also shows that as p is increased, α decreases, in accord with Le Chatelier’s principle. Illustration 7.5 Predicting the effect of compression To predict the effect of an increase in pressure on the composition of the ammonia synthesis at equilibrium, eqn 7.10, we note that the number of gas molecules decreases (from 4 to 2). So, Le Chatelier’s principle predicts that an increase in pressure will favour the product. The equilibrium constant is K = = = where Kx is the part of the equilibrium constant expression that contains the equilibrium mole fractions of reactants and products (note that, unlike K itself, Kx is not an equilibrium constant). Therefore, doubling the pressure must increase Kx by a factor of 4 to preserve the value of K. Self-test 7.4 Predict the effect of a tenfold pressure increase on the equilibrium composition of the reaction 3 N2(g) + H2(g) → 2 N3H(g). [100-fold increase in Kx] 7.4 The response of equilibria to temperature Le Chatelier’s principle predicts that a system at equilibrium will tend to shift in the endothermic direction if the temperature is raised, for then energy is absorbed as heat and the rise in temperature is opposed. Conversely, an equilibrium can be expected to shift in the exothermic direction if the temperature is lowered, for then energy is released and the reduction in temperature is opposed. These conclusions can be summarized as follows: Exothermic reactions: increased temperature favours the reactants. Endothermic reactions: increased temperature favours the products. We shall now justify these remarks and see how to express the changes quantitatively. Kxp72 p2 x2 NH3 p2 p72 xN2 x3 H2 p4 p2 NH3 p72 pN2 p3 H2 D F 1 1 + 4p/Kp7 A C 4α2 (p/p7 ) 1 − α2 x2 Bp2 xApp7 p2 B pAp7 2α 1 + α 1 − α 1 + α (1 − α)n (1 − α)n + 2αn 212 7 CHEMICAL EQUILIBRIUM (a) The van ’t Hoff equation The van ’t Hoff equation, which is derived in the Justification below, is an expression for the slope of a plot of the equilibrium constant (specifically, ln K) as a function of temperature. It may be expressed in either of two ways: (a) = (b) = − (7.23) Justification 7.2 The van ’t Hoff equation From eqn 7.17, we know that ln K = − Differentiation of ln K with respect to temperature then gives = − The differentials are complete because K and ∆rG7 depend only on temperature, not on pressure. To develop this equation we use the Gibbs–Helmholtz equation (eqn 3.53) in the form = − where ∆rH7 is the standard reaction enthalpy at the temperature T. Combining the two equations gives the van ’t Hoff equation, eqn 7.23a. The second form of the equation is obtained by noting that = − , so dT = −T2 d(1/T) It follows that eqn 7.23a can be rewritten as − = which simplifies into eqn 7.23b. Equation 7.23a shows that d ln K/dT < 0 (and therefore that dK/dT < 0) for a reaction that is exothermic under standard conditions (∆rH7 < 0). A negative slope means that ln K, and therefore K itself, decreases as the temperature rises. Therefore, as asserted above, in the case of an exothermic reaction the equilibrium shifts away from products. The opposite occurs in the case of endothermic reactions. Some insight into the thermodynamic basis of this behaviour comes from the expression ∆rG7 = ∆rH7 − T∆rS7 written in the form −∆rG7 /T = −∆rH7 /T + ∆rS7 . When the reaction is exothermic, −∆rH7 /T corresponds to a positive change of entropy of the surroundings and favours the formation of products. When the temperature is raised, −∆rH7 /T decreases, and the increasing entropy of the surroundings has a less important role. As a result, the equilibrium lies less to the right. When the reaction is endothermic, the principal factor is the increasing entropy of the reaction system. The importance of the unfavourable change of entropy of the surroundings is reduced if the temperature is raised (because then ∆rH7 /T is smaller), and the reaction is able to shift towards products. ∆rH7 RT2 d ln K T2 d(1/T) 1 T2 d(1/T) dT ∆rH7 T2 d(∆rG7 /T) dT d(∆rG7 /T) dT 1 R d ln K dT ∆rG7 RT ∆rH7 R d ln K d(1/T) ∆rH7 RT2 d ln K dT 7.4 THE RESPONSE OF EQUILIBRIA TO TEMPERATURE 213 A A B B Population Population Energy Energy Low temperature Low temperature High temperature High temperature (a) (b) Fig. 7.8 The effect of temperature on a chemical equilibrium can be interpreted in terms of the change in the Boltzmann distribution with temperature and the effect of that change in the population of the species. (a) In an endothermic reaction, the population of B increases at the expense of A as the temperature is raised. (b) In an exothermic reaction, the opposite happens. 2.0 2.2 2.4 2.6 2.92.8 0 2 4 6 8 lnK (10 K)/ 3 T Fig. 7.9 When −ln K is plotted against 1/T, a straight line is expected with slope equal to ∆rH7 /R if the standard reaction enthalpy does not vary appreciably with temperature. This is a non-calorimetric method for the measurement of reaction enthalpies. Exploration The equilibrium constant of a reaction is found to fit the expression ln K = a + b/(T/K) + c/(T/K)3 over a range of temperatures. (a) Write expressions for ∆rH7 and ∆rS7 . (b) Plot ln K against 1/T between 400 K and 600 K for a = −2.0, b = −1.0 × 103 , and c = 2.0 × 107 . Molecular interpretation 7.3 The temperature dependence of the equilibrium constant The typical arrangement of energy levels for an endothermic reaction is shown in Fig. 7.8a. When the temperature is increased, the Boltzmann distribution adjusts and the populations change as shown. The change corresponds to an increased population of the higher energy states at the expense of the population of the lower energy states. We see that the states that arise from the B molecules become more populated at the expense of the A molecules. Therefore, the total population of B states increases, and B becomes more abundant in the equilibrium mixture. Conversely, if the reaction is exothermic (Fig. 7.8b), then an increase in temperature increases the population of the A states (which start at higher energy) at the expense of the B states, so the reactants become more abundant. Example 7.3 Measuring a reaction enthalpy The data below show the temperature variation of the equilibrium constant of the reaction Ag2CO3(s) 5 Ag2O(s) + CO2(g). Calculate the standard reaction enthalpy of the decomposition. T/K 350 400 450 500 K 3.98 × 10−4 1.41 × 10−2 1.86 × 10−1 1.48 Method It follows from eqn 7.23b that, provided the reaction enthalpy can be assumed to be independent of temperature, a plot of −ln K against 1/T should be a straight line of slope ∆rH7 /R. Answer We draw up the following table: T/K 350 400 450 500 (103 K)/T 2.86 2.50 2.22 2.00 −ln K 7.83 4.26 1.68 −0.39 These points are plotted in Fig. 7.9. The slope of the graph is +9.6 × 103 , so ∆rH7 = (+9.6 × 103 K) × R = +80 kJ mol−1 214 7 CHEMICAL EQUILIBRIUM Self-test 7.5 The equilibrium constant of the reaction 2 SO2(g) + O2(g) 5 2 SO3(g) is 4.0 × 1024 at 300 K, 2.5 × 1010 at 500 K, and 3.0 × 104 at 700 K. Estimate the reaction enthalpy at 500 K. [−200 kJ mol−1 ] The temperature dependence of the equilibrium constant provides a noncalorimetric method of determining ∆rH7 . A drawback is that the reaction enthalpy is actually temperature-dependent, so the plot is not expected to be perfectly linear. However, the temperature dependence is weak in many cases, so the plot is reasonably straight. In practice, the method is not very accurate, but it is often the only method available. (b) The value of K at different temperatures To find the value of the equilibrium constant at a temperature T2 in terms of its value K1 at another temperature T1, we integrate eqn 7.23b between these two temperatures: ln K2 − ln K1 = − Ύ 1/T2 1/T1 ∆rH7 d(1/T) (7.24) If we suppose that ∆rH7 varies only slightly with temperature over the temperature range of interest, then we may take it outside the integral. It follows that ln K2 − ln K1 = − − (7.25) Illustration 7.6 Estimating an equilibrium constant at a different temperature To estimate the equilibrium constant for the synthesis of ammonia at 500 K from its value at 298 K (6.1 × 105 for the reaction as written in eqn 7.10) we use the standard reaction enthalpy, which can be obtained from Table 2.7 in the Data section by using ∆rH7 = 2∆fH7 (NH3, g), and assume that its value is constant over the range of temperatures. Then, with ∆rH7 = −92.2 kJ mol−1 , from eqn 7.25 we find ln K2 = ln(6.1 × 105 ) − − = −1.71 It follows that K2 = 0.18, a lower value than at 298 K, as expected for this exothermic reaction. Self-test 7.6 The equilibrium constant for N2O4(g) 5 2 NO2(g) was calculated in Self-test 7.1. Estimate its value at 100°C. [15] Knowledge of the temperature dependence of the equilibrium constant for a reaction can be useful in the design of laboratory and industrial processes. For example, synthetic chemists can improve the yield of a reaction by changing the temperature of the reaction mixture. Also, reduction of a metal oxide with carbon or carbon monoxide results in the extraction of the metal when the process is carried out at a temperature for which the equilibrium constant for the reaction is much greater than one. D F 1 298 K 1 500 K A C (−92.2 × 103 J mol−1 ) 8.3145 J K−1 mol−1 D F 1 T1 1 T2 A C ∆rH7 R 1 R 7.4 THE RESPONSE OF EQUILIBRIA TO TEMPERATURE 215 IMPACT ON ENGINEERING I7.1 The extraction of metals from their oxides Metals can be obtained from their oxides by reduction with carbon or carbon monoxide if any of the equilibria MO(s) + C(s) 5 M(s) + CO(g) MO(s) + 1 –2 C(s) 5 M(s) + 1 –2 CO2(g) MO(s) + CO(g) 5 M(s) + CO2(g) lie to the right (that is, have K > 1). As we shall see, these equilibria can be discussed in terms of the thermodynamic functions for the reactions (i) M(s) + 1 –2 O2(g) → MO(s) (ii) 1 –2 C(s) + 1 –2 O2(g) → 1 –2 CO2(g) (iii) C(s) + 1 –2 O2(g) → CO(g) (iv) CO(g) + 1 –2 O2(g) → CO2(g) The temperature dependences of the standard Gibbs energies of reactions (i)–(iv) depend on the reaction entropy through d∆rG7 /dT = −∆rS7 . Because in reaction (iii) there is a net increase in the amount of gas, the standard reaction entropy is large and positive; therefore, its ∆rG7 decreases sharply with increasing temperature. In reaction (iv), there is a similar net decrease in the amount of gas, so ∆rG7 increases sharply with increasing temperature. In reaction (ii), the amount of gas is constant, so the entropy change is small and ∆rG7 changes only slightly with temperature. These remarks are summarized in Fig. 7.10, which is called an Ellingham diagram. Note that ∆rG7 decreases upwards! At room temperature, ∆rG7 is dominated by the contribution of the reaction enthalpy (T∆rS7 being relatively small), so the order of increasing ∆rG7 is the same as the order of increasing ∆rH7 (Al2O3 is most exothermic; Ag2O is least). The standard reaction entropy is similar for all metals because in each case gaseous oxygen is eliminated and a compact, solid oxide is formed. As a result, the temperature dependence of the standard Gibbs energy of oxidation should be similar for all metals, as is shown by the similar slopes of the lines in the diagram. The kinks at high temperatures correspond to the evaporation of the metals; less pronounced kinks occur at the melting temperatures of the metals and the oxides. Successful reduction of the oxide depends on the outcome of the competition of the carbon for the oxygen bound to the metal. The standard Gibbs energies for the reductions can be expressed in terms of the standard Gibbs energies for the reactions above: MO(s) + C(s) → M(s) + CO(g) ∆rG7 = ∆rG7 (iii) − ∆rG7 (i) MO(s) + 1 –2 C(s) → M(s) + 1 –2 CO2(g) ∆rG7 = ∆rG7 (ii) − ∆rG7 (i) MO(s) + CO(g) → M(s) + CO2(g) ∆rG7 = ∆rG7 (iv) − ∆rG7 (i) The equilibrium lies to the right if ∆rG7 < 0. This is the case when the line for reaction (i) lies below (is more positive than) the line for one of the reactions (ii) to (iv). The spontaneity of a reduction at any temperature can be predicted simply by looking at the diagram: a metal oxide is reduced by any carbon reaction lying above it, because the overall reaction then has ∆rG7 < 0. For example, CuO can be reduced to Cu at any temperature above room temperature. Even in the absence of carbon, Ag2O decomposes when heated above 200°C because then the standard Gibbs energy for reaction (i) becomes positive (and the reverse reaction is then spontaneous). On the other hand, Al2O3 is not reduced by carbon until the temperature has been raised to above 2000°C. 500 1000 1500 2000 2500 –500 –300 –400 –100 –200 +100 0 0 Temperature, /°C Reaction (iv) Reaction (ii) Reaction (iii) FeO PbO CuO Ag O2 Dr –1 G/(kJmol) Æ 1 3 2 3Al O 1 2 2TiO 1 2 2SiO ZnO q Fig. 7.10 An Ellingham diagram for the discussion of the reduction of metal ores. 216 7 CHEMICAL EQUILIBRIUM Equilibrium electrochemistry We shall now see how the foregoing ideas, with certain changes of technical detail, can be used to describe the equilibrium properties of reactions taking place in electrochemical cells. The ability to make very precise measurements of currents and potential differences (‘voltages’) means that electrochemical methods can be used to determine thermodynamic properties of reactions that may be inaccessible by other methods. An electrochemical cell consists of two electrodes, or metallic conductors, in contact with an electrolyte, an ionic conductor (which may be a solution, a liquid, or a solid). An electrode and its electrolyte comprise an electrode compartment. The two electrodes may share the same compartment. The various kinds of electrode are summarized in Table 7.1. Any ‘inert metal’ shown as part of the specification is present to act as a source or sink of electrons, but takes no other part in the reaction other than acting as a catalyst for it. If the electrolytes are different, the two compartments may be joined by a salt bridge, which is a tube containing a concentrated electrolyte solution (almost always potassium chloride in agar jelly) that completes the electrical circuit and enables the cell to function. A galvanic cell is an electrochemical cell that produces electricity as a result of the spontaneous reaction occurring inside it. An electrolytic cell is an electrochemical cell in which a non-spontaneous reaction is driven by an external source of current. 7.5 Half-reactions and electrodes It will be familiar from introductory chemistry courses that oxidation is the removal of electrons from a species, a reduction is the addition of electrons to a species, and a redox reaction is a reaction in which there is a transfer of electrons from one species to another. The electron transfer may be accompanied by other events, such as atom or ion transfer, but the net effect is electron transfer and hence a change in oxidation number of an element. The reducing agent (or ‘reductant’) is the electron donor; the oxidizing agent (or ‘oxidant’) is the electron acceptor. It should also be familiar that any redox reaction may be expressed as the difference of two reduction halfreactions, which are conceptual reactions showing the gain of electrons. Even reactions that are not redox reactions may often be expressed as the difference of two reduction half-reactions. The reduced and oxidized species in a half-reaction form a redox couple. In general we write a couple as Ox/Red and the corresponding reduction half-reaction as Ox + ν e− → Red (7.26) Table 7.1 Varieties of electrode Electrode type Designation Redox couple Half-reaction Metal/metal ion M(s)|M+ (aq) M+ /M M+ (aq) + e− → M(s) Gas Pt(s)|X2(g)|X+ (aq) X+ /X2 X+ (aq) + e− → 1 –2 X2(g) Pt(s)|X2(g)|X− (aq) X2/X− 1 –2 X2(g) + e− → X− (aq) Metal/insoluble salt M(s)|MX(s)|X− (aq) MX/M,X− MX(s) + e− → M(s) + X− (aq) Redox Pt(s)|M+ (aq),M2+ (aq) M2+ /M+ M2+ (aq) + e− → M+ (aq) 7.6 VARIETIES OF CELLS 217 Reduction Anode Cathode - + Electrons Oxidation Fig. 7.11 When a spontaneous reaction takes place in a galvanic cell, electrons are deposited in one electrode (the site of oxidation, the anode) and collected from another (the site of reduction, the cathode), and so there is a net flow of current which can be used to do work. Note that the + sign of the cathode can be interpreted as indicating the electrode at which electrons enter the cell, and the − sign of the anode is where the electrons leave the cell. Illustration 7.7 Expressing a reaction in terms of half-reactions The dissolution of silver chloride in water AgCl(s) → Ag+ (aq) + Cl− (aq), which is not a redox reaction, can be expressed as the difference of the following two reduction half-reactions: AgCl(s) + e− → Ag(s) + Cl− (aq) Ag+ (aq) + e− → Ag(s) The redox couples are AgCl/Ag,Cl− and Ag+ /Ag, respectively. Self-test 7.7 Express the formation of H2O from H2 and O2 in acidic solution (a redox reaction) as the difference of two reduction half-reactions. [4 H+ (aq) + 4 e− → 2 H2(g), O2(g) + 4 H+ (aq) + 4 e− → 2 H2O(l)] We shall often find it useful to express the composition of an electrode compartment in terms of the reaction quotient, Q, for the half-reaction. This quotient is defined like the reaction quotient for the overall reaction, but the electrons are ignored. Illustration 7.8 Writing the reaction quotient of a half-reaction The reaction quotient for the reduction of O2 to H2O in acid solution, O2(g) + 4 H+ (aq) + 4 e− → 2 H2O(l), is Q = ≈ The approximations used in the second step are that the activity of water is 1 (because the solution is dilute) and the oxygen behaves as a perfect gas, so aO2 ≈ pO2 /p7 . Self-test 7.8 Write the half-reaction and the reaction quotient for a chlorine gas electrode. [Cl2(g) + 2 e− → 2 Cl− (aq), Q = a2 Cl−p7 /pCl2 ] The reduction and oxidation processes responsible for the overall reaction in a cell are separated in space: oxidation takes place at one electrode and reduction takes place at the other. As the reaction proceeds, the electrons released in the oxidation Red1 → Ox1 + ν e− at one electrode travel through the external circuit and re-enter the cell through the other electrode. There they bring about reduction Ox2 + ν e− → Red2. The electrode at which oxidation occurs is called the anode; the electrode at which reduction occurs is called the cathode. In a galvanic cell, the cathode has a higher potential than the anode: the species undergoing reduction, Ox2, withdraws electrons from its electrode (the cathode, Fig. 7.11), so leaving a relative positive charge on it (corresponding to a high potential). At the anode, oxidation results in the transfer of electrons to the electrode, so giving it a relative negative charge (corresponding to a low potential). 7.6 Varieties of cells The simplest type of cell has a single electrolyte common to both electrodes (as in Fig.7.11).Insomecasesitisnecessarytoimmersetheelectrodesindifferentelectrolytes, p7 a4 H+pO2 a2 H2O a4 H+aO2 218 7 CHEMICAL EQUILIBRIUM as in the ‘Daniell cell’ in which the redox couple at one electrode is Cu2+ /Cu and at the other is Zn2+ /Zn (Fig. 7.12). In an electrolyte concentration cell, the electrode compartments are identical except for the concentrations of the electrolytes. In an electrode concentration cell the electrodes themselves have different concentrations, either because they are gas electrodes operating at different pressures or because they are amalgams (solutions in mercury) with different concentrations. (a) Liquid junction potentials In a cell with two different electrolyte solutions in contact, as in the Daniell cell, there is an additional source of potential difference across the interface of the two electrolytes. This potential is called the liquid junction potential, Elj. Another example of a junction potential is that between different concentrations of hydrochloric acid. At the junction, the mobile H+ ions diffuse into the more dilute solution. The bulkier Cl− ions follow, but initially do so more slowly, which results in a potential difference at the junction. The potential then settles down to a value such that, after that brief initial period, the ions diffuse at the same rates. Electrolyte concentration cells always have a liquid junction; electrode concentration cells do not. The contribution of the liquid junction to the potential can be reduced (to about 1 to 2 mV) by joining the electrolyte compartments through a salt bridge (Fig. 7.13). The reason for the success of the salt bridge is that the liquid junction potentials at either end are largely independent of the concentrations of the two dilute solutions, and so nearly cancel. (b) Notation In the notation for cells, phase boundaries are denoted by a vertical bar. For example, the cell in Fig. 7.11 is denoted Pt(s)|H2(g) |HCl(aq)|AgCl(s)|Ag(s) A liquid junction is denoted by Ӈ, so the cell in Fig. 7.12, is denoted Zn(s)|ZnSO4(aq)ӇCuSO4(aq)|Cu(s) A double vertical line, ||, denotes an interface for which it is assumed that the junction potential has been eliminated. Thus the cell in Fig. 7.13 is denoted Zn(s)|ZnSO4(aq)||CuSO4(aq)|Cu(s) An example of an electrolyte concentration cell in which the liquid junction potential is assumed to be eliminated is Pt(s)|H2(g) |HCl(aq, b1)||HCl(aq, b2)|H2(g) |Pt(s). 7.7 The electromotive force The current produced by a galvanic cell arises from the spontaneous chemical reaction taking place inside it. The cell reaction is the reaction in the cell written on the assumption that the right-hand electrode is the cathode, and hence that the spontaneous reaction is one in which reduction is taking place in the right-hand compartment. Later we see how to predict if the right-hand electrode is in fact the cathode; if it is, then the cell reaction is spontaneous as written. If the left-hand electrode turns out to be the cathode, then the reverse of the corresponding cell reaction is spontaneous. To write the cell reaction corresponding to a cell diagram, we first write the righthand half-reaction as a reduction (because we have assumed that to be spontaneous). Then we subtract from it the left-hand reduction half-reaction (for, by implication, that Zinc Copper Zinc sulfate solution Copper(II) sulfate solution Porous pot +Fig. 7.12 One version of the Daniell cell. The copper electrode is the cathode and the zinc electrode is the anode. Electrons leave the cell from the zinc electrode and enter it again through the copper electrode. Electrode Electrode Salt bridge Electrode compartments Zn ZnSO (aq)4 CuSO (aq)4 Cu Fig. 7.13 The salt bridge, essentially an inverted U-tube full of concentrated salt solution in a jelly, has two opposing liquid junction potentials that almost cancel. 7.7 THE ELECTROMOTIVE FORCE 219 electrode is the site of oxidation). Thus, in the cell Zn(s)|ZnSO4(aq)||CuSO4(aq)|Cu(s) the two electrodes and their reduction half-reactions are Right-hand electrode: Cu2+ (aq) + 2 e− → Cu(s) Left-hand electrode: Zn2+ (aq) + 2 e− → Zn(s) Hence, the overall cell reaction is the difference: Cu2+ (aq) + Zn(s) → Cu(s) + Zn2+ (aq) (a) The Nernst equation A cell in which the overall cell reaction has not reached chemical equilibrium can do electrical work as the reaction drives electrons through an external circuit. The work that a given transfer of electrons can accomplish depends on the potential difference between the two electrodes. This potential difference is called the cell potential and is measured in volts, V (1 V = 1 J C−1 s). When the cell potential is large, a given number of electrons travelling between the electrodes can do a large amount of electrical work. When the cell potential is small, the same number of electrons can do only a small amount of work. A cell in which the overall reaction is at equilibrium can do no work, and then the cell potential is zero. According to the discussion in Section 3.5e, we know that the maximum nonexpansion work, which in the current context is electrical work, that a system (the cell) can do is given by eqn 3.38 (we,max = ∆G), with ∆G identified (as we shall show) with the Gibbs energy of the cell reaction, ∆rG. It follows that, to draw thermodynamic conclusions from measurements of the work a cell can do, we must ensure that the cell is operating reversibly, for only then is it producing maximum work. Moreover, we saw in Section 7.1a that the reaction Gibbs energy is actually a property relating to a specified composition of the reaction mixture. Therefore, to make use of ∆rG we must ensure that the cell is operating reversibly at a specific, constant composition. Both these conditions are achieved by measuring the cell potential when it is balanced by an exactly opposing source of potential so that the cell reaction occurs reversibly, the composition is constant, and no current flows: in effect, the cell reaction is poised for change, but not actually changing. The resulting potential difference is called the electromotive force (emf), E, of the cell. As we show in the Justification below, the relation between the reaction Gibbs energy and the emf of the cell is −νFE = ∆rG (7.27) where F is Faraday’s constant, F = eNA, and ν is the stoichiometric coefficient of the electrons in the half-reactions into which the cell reaction can be divided. This equation is the key connection between electrical measurements on the one hand and thermodynamic properties on the other. It will be the basis of all that follows. Justification 7.3 The relation between the electromotive force and the reaction Gibbs energy We consider the change in G when the cell reaction advances by an infinitesimal amount dξ at some composition. From eqn 7.15 we can write (at constant temperature and pressure) dG = ∆rGdξ The maximum non-expansion (electrical) work that the reaction can do as it advances by dξ at constant temperature and pressure is therefore dwe = ∆rGdξ 220 7 CHEMICAL EQUILIBRIUM DrG E < 0, > 0 DrG E = 0, = 0 DrG E > 0, < 0 Extent of reaction, Gibbsenergy,G x Fig. 7.14 A spontaneous reaction occurs in the direction of decreasing Gibbs energy. When expressed in terms of a cell potential, the spontaneous direction of change can be expressed in terms of the cell emf, E. The reaction is spontaneous as written (from left to right on the illustration) when E > 0. The reverse reaction is spontaneous when E < 0. When the cell reaction is at equilibrium, the cell potential is zero. This work is infinitesimal, and the composition of the system is virtually constant when it occurs. Suppose that the reaction advances by dξ, then νdξ electrons must travel from the anode to the cathode. The total charge transported between the electrodes when this change occurs is −νeNAdξ (because νdξ is the amount of electrons and the charge per mole of electrons is −eNA). Hence, the total charge transported is −νFdξ because eNA = F. The work done when an infinitesimal charge −νFdξ travels from the anode to the cathode is equal to the product of the charge and the potential difference E (see Table 2.1 and Appendix 3): dwe = −νFEdξ When we equate this relation to the one above (dwe = ∆rGdξ), the advancement dξ cancels, and we obtain eqn 7.27. It follows from eqn 7.27 that, by knowing the reaction Gibbs energy at a specified composition, we can state the cell emf at that composition. Note that a negative reaction Gibbs energy, corresponding to a spontaneous cell reaction, corresponds to a positive cell emf. Another way of looking at the content of eqn 7.27 is that it shows that the driving power of a cell (that is, its emf) is proportional to the slope of the Gibbs energy with respect to the extent of reaction. It is plausible that a reaction that is far from equilibrium (when the slope is steep) has a strong tendency to drive electrons through an external circuit (Fig. 7.14). When the slope is close to zero (when the cell reaction is close to equilibrium), the emf is small. Illustration 7.9 Converting between the cell emf and the reaction Gibbs energy Equation 7.27 provides an electrical method for measuring a reaction Gibbs energy at any composition of the reaction mixture: we simply measure the cell’s emf and convert it to ∆rG. Conversely, if we know the value of ∆rG at a particular composition, then we can predict the emf. For example, if ∆rG = −1 × 102 kJ mol−1 and ν = 1, then E = − = − = 1 V where we have used 1 J = 1 C V. We can go on to relate the emf to the activities of the participants in the cell reaction. We know that the reaction Gibbs energy is related to the composition of the reaction mixture by eqn 7.11 (∆rG = ∆rG7 + RT ln Q); it follows, on division of both sides by −νF, that E = − − ln Q The first term on the right is written E7 = − [7.28] and called the standard emf of the cell. That is, the standard emf is the standard reaction Gibbs energy expressed as a potential (in volts). It follows that ∆rG7 νF RT νF ∆rG7 νF (−1 × 105 J mol−1 ) 1 × (9.6485 × 104 C mol−1 ) ∆rG νF 7.7 THE ELECTROMOTIVE FORCE 221 -3 -2 -1 0 1 2 3 log Q 8 6 4 2 0 -2 -4 -6 -8 1 2 3 n ()/(/)EERTF- Æ Fig. 7.15 The variation of cell emf with the value of the reaction quotient for the cell reaction for different values of ν (the number of electrons transferred). At 298 K, RT/F = 25.69 mV, so the vertical scale refers to multiples of this value. Exploration Plot the variation of cell emf with the value of the reaction quotient for the cell reaction for different values of the temperature. Does the cell emf become more or less sensitive to composition as the temperature increases? E = E7 − ln Q (7.29) This equation for the emf in terms of the composition is called the Nernst equation; the dependence of cell potential on composition that it predicts is summarized in Fig. 7.15. One important application of the Nernst equation is to the determination of the pH of a solution and, with a suitable choice of electrodes, of the concentration of other ions (Section 7.9c). We see from eqn 7.29 that the standard emf (which will shortly move to centre stage of the exposition) can be interpreted as the emf when all the reactants and products in the cell reaction are in their standard states, for then all activities are 1, so Q = 1 and ln Q = 0. However, the fact that the standard emf is merely a disguised form of the standard reaction Gibbs energy (eqn 7.28) should always be kept in mind and underlies all its applications. Illustration 7.10 Using the Nernst equation Because RT/F = 25.7 mV at 25°C, a practical form of the Nernst equation is E = E7 − ln Q It then follows that, for a reaction in which ν = 1, if Q is increased by a factor of 10, then the emf decreases by 59.2 mV. (b) Cells at equilibrium A special case of the Nernst equation has great importance in electrochemistry and provides a link to the earlier part of the chapter. Suppose the reaction has reached equilibrium; then Q = K, where K is the equilibrium constant of the cell reaction. However, a chemical reaction at equilibrium cannot do work, and hence it generates zero potential difference between the electrodes of a galvanic cell. Therefore, setting E = 0 and Q = K in the Nernst equation gives ln K = (7.30) This very important equation (which could also have been obtained more directly by substituting eqn 7.29 into eqn 7.17) lets us predict equilibrium constants from measured standard cell potentials. However, before we use it extensively, we need to establish a further result. Illustration 7.11 Calculating an equilibrium constant from a standard cell potential Because the standard emf of the Daniell cell is +1.10 V, the equilibrium constant for the cell reaction Cu2+ (aq) + Zn(s) → Cu(s) + Zn2+ (aq), for which ν = 2, is K = 1.5 × 1037 at 298 K. We conclude that the displacement of copper by zinc goes virtually to completion. Note that an emf of about 1 V is easily measurable but corresponds to an equilibrium constant that would be impossible to measure by direct chemical analysis. νFE7 RT 25.7 mV ν RT νF 222 7 CHEMICAL EQUILIBRIUM 7.8 Standard potentials A galvanic cell is a combination of two electrodes, and each one can be considered as making a characteristic contribution to the overall cell potential. Although it is not possible to measure the contribution of a single electrode, we can define the potential of one of the electrodes as zero and then assign values to others on that basis. The specially selected electrode is the standard hydrogen electrode (SHE): Pt(s)|H2(g) |H+ (aq) E7 = 0 [7.31] at all temperatures. To achieve the standard conditions, the activity of the hydrogen ions must be 1 (that is, pH = 0) and the pressure (more precisely, the fugacity) of the hydrogen gas must be 1 bar. The standard potential, E 7 , of another couple is then assigned by constructing a cell in which it is the right-hand electrode and the standard hydrogen electrode is the left-hand electrode. The procedure for measuring a standard potential can be illustrated by considering a specific case, the silver chloride electrode. The measurement is made on the ‘Harned cell’: Pt(s)|H2(g) |HCl(aq)|AgCl(s)|Ag(s) 1 –2 H2(g) + AgCl(s) → HCl(aq) + Ag(s) for which the Nernst equation is E = E 7 (AgCl/Ag, Cl− ) − ln We shall set aH2 = 1 from now on, and for simplicity write the standard potential as E 7 ; then E = E7 − ln aH+aCl− The activities can be expressed in terms of the molality b of HCl(aq) through aH+ = γ±b/b7 and aCl− = γ±b/b7 as we saw in Section 5.9), so E = E7 − ln b2 − ln γ± 2 where for simplicity we have replaced b/b7 by b. This expression rearranges to E + ln b = E 7 − ln γ± {7.32} From the Debye–Hückel limiting law for a 1,1-electrolyte (Section 5.9; a 1,1electrolyte is a solution of singly charged M+ and X− ions), we know that ln γ± ∝ −b1/2 . The natural logarithm used here is proportional to the common logarithm that appears in eqn 5.69 (because ln x = ln 10 log x = 2.303 log x). Therefore, with the constant of proportionality in this relation written as (F/2RT)C, eqn 7.32 becomes E + ln b = E7 + Cb1/2 {7.33} The expression on the left is evaluated at a range of molalities, plotted against b1/2 , and extrapolated to b = 0. The intercept at b1/2 = 0 is the value of E 7 for the silver/ silver-chloride electrode. In precise work, the b1/2 term is brought to the left, and a higher-order correction term from the extended Debye–Hückel law is used on the right. 2RT F 2RT F 2RT F RT F RT F RT F aH+aCl− a1/2 H2 RT F 7.8 STANDARD POTENTIALS 223 0 1.0 2.0 Eb/V+0.05139ln ( /10 )b b-3 Æ 3.0 4.0 5.0 0.2250 0.2260 0.2270 0.2280 0.2290 0.2300 0.2240 0.2230 1/2 Fig. 7.16 The plot and the extrapolation used for the experimental measurement of a standard cell emf. The intercept at b1/2 = 0 is E 7 . Exploration Suppose that the procedure in Illustration 7.12 results in a plot that deviates from linearity. What might be the cause of this behaviour? How might you modify the procedure to obtain a reliable value of the standard potential? Synoptic Table 7.2* Standard potentials at 298 K Couple E7 /V Ce4+ (aq) + e− → Ce3+ (aq) +1.61 Cu2+ (aq) + 2 e− → Cu(s) +0.34 H+ (aq) + e− → 1 –2 H2(g) 0 AgCl(s) + e− → Ag(s) + Cl− (aq) +0.22 Zn2+ (aq) + 2 e− → Zn(s) −0.76 Na+ (aq) + e− → Na(s) −2.71 * More values are given in the Data section. Illustration 7.12 Determining the standard emf of a cell The emf of the cell Pt(s)|H2(g, p7 )|HCl(aq, b)|AgCl(s)|Ag(s) at 25°C has the following values: b/(10−3 b7 ) 3.215 5.619 9.138 25.63 E/V 0.52053 0.49257 0.46860 0.41824 To determine the standard emf of the cell we draw up the following table, using 2RT/F = 0.051 39 V: b/(10−3 b7 ) 3.215 5.619 9.138 25.63 {b/(10−3 b7 )}1/2 1.793 2.370 3.023 5.063 E/V 0.52053 0.49257 0.46860 0.41824 E/V + 0.051 39 ln b 0.2256 0.2263 0.2273 0.2299 The data are plotted in Fig. 7.16; as can be seen, they extrapolate to E7 = 0.2232 V. Self-test 7.9 The data below are for the cell Pt(s)|H2(g, p7 )|HBr(aq, b)| AgBr(s)|Ag(s) at 25°C. Determine the standard emf of the cell. b/(10−4 b7 ) 4.042 8.444 37.19 E/V 0.47381 0.43636 0.36173 [0.071 V] Table 7.2 lists standard potentials at 298 K. An important feature of standard emf of cells and standard potentials of electrodes is that they are unchanged if the chemical equation for the cell reaction or a half-reaction is multiplied by a numerical factor. A numerical factor increases the value of the standard Gibbs energy for the reaction. However, it also increases the number of electrons transferred by the same factor, and by eqn 7.27 the value of E 7 remains unchanged. A practical consequence is that a cell emf is independent of the physical size of the cell. In other words, cell emf is an intensive property. The standard potentials in Table 7.2 may be combined to give values for couples that are not listed there. However, to do so, we must take into account the fact that different couples may correspond to the transfer of different numbers of electrons. The procedure is illustrated in the following Example. Example 7.4 Evaluating a standard potential from two others Given that the standard potentials of the Cu2+ /Cu and Cu+ /Cu couples are +0.340 V and +0.522 V, respectively, evaluate E 7 (Cu2+ ,Cu+ ). Method First, we note that reaction Gibbs energies may be added (as in a Hess’s law analysis of reaction enthalpies). Therefore, we should convert the E 7 values to ∆G7 values by using eqn 7.27, add them appropriately, and then convert the overall ∆G7 to the required E7 by using eqn 7.27 again. This roundabout procedure is necessary because, as we shall see, although the factor F cancels, the factor ν in general does not. Answer The electrode reactions are as follows: (a) Cu2+ (aq) + 2 e− → Cu(s) E7 = +0.340 V, so ∆rG7 = −2(0.340 V)F (b) Cu+ (aq) + e− → Cu(s) E7 = +0.522 V, so ∆rG7 = −(0.522 V)F 224 7 CHEMICAL EQUILIBRIUM The required reaction is (c) Cu2+ (aq) + e− → Cu+ (aq) E7 = −∆rG7 /F Because (c) = (a) − (b), the standard Gibbs energy of reaction (c) is ∆rG7 = ∆rG7 (a) − ∆rG7 (b) = −(−0.158 V) × F Therefore, E 7 = +0.158 V. Note that the generalization of the calculation we just performed is νcE7 (c) = νaE7 (a) + νbE7 (b) (7.34) A note on good practice Whenever combining standard potentials to obtain the standard potential of a third couple, always work via the Gibbs energies because they are additive, whereas, in general, standard potentials are not. Self-test 7.10 Calculate the standard potential of the Fe3+ /Fe couple from the values for the Fe3+ /Fe2+ and Fe2+ /Fe couples. [−0.037 V] 7.9 Applications of standard potentials Cell emfs are a convenient source of data on equilibrium constants and the Gibbs energies, enthalpies, and entropies of reactions. In practice the standard values of these quantities are the ones normally determined. (a) The electrochemical series We have seen that for two redox couples, Ox1/Red1 and Ox2/Red2, and the cell Red1,Ox1 ||Red2,Ox2 E7 = E2 7 − E1 7 (7.35a) that the cell reaction Red1 + Ox2 → Ox1 + Red2 (7.35b) is spontaneous as written if E7 > 0, and therefore if E2 7 > E1 7 . Because in the cell reaction Red1 reduces Ox2, we can conclude that Red1 has a thermodynamic tendency to reduce Ox2 if E1 7 < E2 7 More briefly: low reduces high. Illustration 7.13 Using the electrochemical series Because E7 (Zn2+ ,Zn) = −0.76 V < E7 (Cu2+ ,Cu) = +0.34 V, zinc has a thermodynamic tendency to reduce Cu2+ ions in aqueous solution. Table 7.3 shows a part of the electrochemical series, the metallic elements (and hydrogen) arranged in the order of their reducing power as measured by their standard potentials in aqueous solution. A metal low in the series (with a lower standard potential) can reduce the ions of metals with higher standard potentials. This conclusion is qualitative. The quantitative value of K is obtained by doing the calculations we have described previously. For example, to determine whether zinc can displace magnesium from aqueous solutions at 298 K, we note that zinc lies above magnesium Table 7.3 The electrochemical series of the metals* Least strongly reducing Gold Platinum Silver Mercury Copper (Hydrogen) Lead Tin Nickel Iron Zinc Chromium Aluminium Magnesium Sodium Calcium Potassium Most strongly reducing * The complete series can be inferred from Table 7.2. 7.9 APPLICATIONS OF STANDARD POTENTIALS 225 in the electrochemical series, so zinc cannot reduce magnesium ions in aqueous solution. Zinc can reduce hydrogen ions, because hydrogen lies higher in the series. However, even for reactions that are thermodynamically favourable, there may be kinetic factors that result in very slow rates of reaction. The reactions of the electron transport chains of respiration are good applications of this principle. IMPACT ON BIOCHEMISTRY I7.2 Energy conversion in biological cells The whole of life’s activities depends on the coupling of exergonic and endergonic reactions, for the oxidation of food drives other reactions forward. In biological cells, the energy released by the oxidation of foods is stored in adenosine triphosphate (ATP, 1). The essence of the action of ATP is its ability to lose its terminal phosphate group by hydrolysis and to form adenosine diphosphate (ADP): ATP(aq) + H2O(l) → ADP(aq) + Pi − (aq) + H3O+ (aq) where Pi − denotes an inorganic phosphate group, such as H2PO4 − . The biological standard values for ATP hydrolysis at 37°C (310 K, blood temperature) are ∆rG⊕ = −31 kJ mol−1 , ∆rH⊕ = −20 kJ mol−1 , and ∆rS⊕ = +34 J K−1 mol−1 . The hydrolysis is therefore exergonic (∆rG⊕ < 0) under these conditions and 31 kJ mol−1 is available for driving other reactions. Moreover, because the reaction entropy is large, the reaction Gibbs energy is sensitive to temperature. In view of its exergonicity the ADP-phosphate bond has been called a ‘high-energy phosphate bond’. The name is intended to signify a high tendency to undergo reaction, and should not be confused with ‘strong’ bond. In fact, even in the biological sense it is not of very ‘high energy’. The action of ATP depends on it being intermediate in activity. Thus ATP acts as a phosphate donor to a number of acceptors (for example, glucose), but is recharged by more powerful phosphate donors in a number of biochemical processes. We now use the oxidation of glucose to CO2 and H2O by O2 as an example of how the breakdown of foods is coupled to the formation of ATP in the cell. The process begins with glycolysis, a partial oxidation of glucose by nicotinamide adenine dinucleotide (NAD+ , 2) to pyruvate ion, CH3COCO2 − , continues with the citric acid cycle, whichoxidizespyruvatetoCO2,andendswithoxidativephosphorylation,whichreduces O2 to H2O. Glycolysis is the main source of energy during anaerobic metabolism, a form of metabolism in which inhaled O2 does not play a role. The citric acid cycle and oxidative phosphorylation are the main mechanisms for the extraction of energy from carbohydrates during aerobic metabolism, a form of metabolism in which inhaled O2 does play a role. 226 7 CHEMICAL EQUILIBRIUM Glycolysis Glycolysis occurs in the cytosol, the aqueous material encapsulated by the cell membrane, and consists of ten enzyme-catalysed reactions. At blood temperature, ∆rG⊕ = −147 kJ mol−1 for the oxidation of glucose by NAD+ to pyruvate ions. The oxidation of one glucose molecule is coupled to the conversion of two ADP molecules to two ATP molecules, so the net reaction of glycolysis is: C6H12O6(aq) + 2 NAD+ (aq) + 2 ADP(aq) + 2 Pi − (aq) + 2 H2O(l) → 2 CH3COCO2 − (aq) + 2 NADH(aq) + 2 ATP(aq) + 2 H3O+ (aq) The standard reaction Gibbs energy is (−147) − 2(−31) kJ mol−1 = −85 kJ mol−1 . The reaction is exergonic, and therefore spontaneous: the oxidation of glucose is used to ‘recharge’ the ATP. In cells that are deprived of O2, pyruvate ion is reduced to lactate ion, CH3C(OH)CO2 − , by NADH.2 Very strenuous exercise, such as bicycle racing, can decrease sharply the concentration of O2 in muscle cells and the condition known as muscle fatigue results from increased concentrations of lactate ion. The citric acid cycle The standard Gibbs energy of combustion of glucose is −2880 kJ mol−1 , so terminating its oxidation at pyruvate is a poor use of resources. In the presence of O2, pyruvate is oxidized further during the citric acid cycle and oxidative phosphorylation, which occur in a special compartment of the cell called the mitochondrion. The citric acid cycle requires eight enzymes that couple the synthesis of ATP to the oxidation of pyruvate by NAD+ and flavin adenine dinucleotide (FAD, 3): 2 CH3COCO2 − (aq) + 8 NAD+ (aq) + 2 FAD(aq) + 2 ADP(aq) + 2 Pi (aq) + 8 H2O(l) → 6 CO2(g) + 8 NADH(aq) + 4 H3O+ (aq) + 2 FADH2(aq) + 2 ATP(aq) The NADH and FADH2 go on to reduce O2 during oxidative phosphorylation, which also produces ATP. The citric acid cycle and oxidative phosphorylation generate as many as 38 ATP molecules for each glucose molecule consumed. Each mole of ATP molecules extracts 31 kJ from the 2880 kJ supplied by 1 mol C6H12O6 (180 g of 2 In yeast, the terminal products are ethanol and CO2. 7.9 APPLICATIONS OF STANDARD POTENTIALS 227 glucose), so 1178 kJ is stored for later use. Therefore, aerobic oxidation of glucose is much more efficient than glycolysis. In the cell, each ATP molecule can be used to drive an endergonic reaction for which ∆rG⊕ does not exceed +31 kJ mol−1 . For example, the biosynthesis of sucrose from glucose and fructose can be driven by plant enzymes because the reaction is endergonic to the extent ∆rG⊕ = +23 kJ mol−1 . The biosynthesis of proteins is strongly endergonic, not only on account of the enthalpy change but also on account of the large decrease in entropy that occurs when many amino acids are assembled into a precisely determined sequence. For instance, the formation of a peptide link is endergonic, with ∆rG⊕ = +17 kJ mol−1 , but the biosynthesis occurs indirectly and is equivalent to the consumption of three ATP molecules for each link. In a moderately small protein like myoglobin, with about 150 peptide links, the construction alone requires 450 ATP molecules, and therefore about 12 mol of glucose molecules for 1 mol of protein molecules. The respiratory chain In the exergonic oxidation of glucose 24 electrons are transferred from each C6H12O6 molecule to six O2 molecules. The half-reactions for the oxidation of glucose and the reduction of O2 are C6H12O6(s) + 6 H2O(l) → 6 CO2(g) + 24 H+ (aq) + 24 e− 6 O2(g) + 24 H+ (aq) + 24 e− → 12 H2O(l) The electrons do not flow directly from glucose to O2. We have already seen that, in biological cells, glucose is oxidized to CO2 by NAD+ and FAD during glycolysis and the citric acid cycle: C6H12O6(s) + 10 NAD+ + 2 FAD + 4 ADP + 4 Pi − + 2 H2O → 6 CO2 + 10 NADH + 2 FADH2 + 4 ATP + 6 H+ 228 7 CHEMICAL EQUILIBRIUM In the respiratory chain, electrons from the powerful reducing agents NADH and FADH2 pass through four membrane-bound protein complexes and two mobile electron carriers before reducing O2 to H2O. We shall see that the electron transfer reactions drive the synthesis of ATP at three of the membrane protein complexes. The respiratory chain begins in complex I (NADH-Q oxidoreductase), where NADH is oxidized by coenzyme Q (Q, 4) in a two-electron reaction: H+ + NADH + Q –co ––mp ––lex I ––→ NAD+ + QH2 E⊕ = +0.42 V, ∆rG⊕ = −81 kJ mol−1 Additional Q molecules are reduced by FADH2 in complex II (succinate-Q reductase): FADH2 + Q –co ––mp ––lex II ––→ FAD + QH2 E⊕ = +0.015 V, ∆rG⊕ = −2.9 kJ mol−1 Reduced Q migrates to complex III (Q-cytochrome c oxidoreductase), which catalyses the reduction of the protein cytochrome c (Cyt c). Cytochrome c contains the haem c group (5), the central iron ion of which can exist in oxidation states +3 and +2. The net reaction catalysed by complex III is QH2 + 2 Fe3+ (Cyt c) –co ––mp ––lex III –––→ Q + 2 Fe2+ (Cyt c) + 2 H+ E⊕ = +0.15 V, ∆rG⊕ = −30 kJ mol−1 Reduced cytochrome c carries electrons from complex III to complex IV (cytochrome c oxidase), where O2 is reduced to H2O: 2 Fe2+ (Cyt c) + 2 H+ + 1 –2 O2 complex IV → 2 Fe3+ (Cyt c) + H2O E⊕ = +0.815 V, ∆rG⊕ = −109 kJ mol−1 Oxidative phosphorylation The reactions that occur in complexes I, III, and IV are sufficiently exergonic to drive the synthesis of ATP in the process called oxidative phosphorylation: ADP + Pi − + H+ → ATP ∆rG⊕ = +31 kJ mol−1 We saw above that the phosphorylation of ADP to ATP can be coupled to the exergonic dephosphorylation of other molecules. Indeed, this is the mechanism by which ATP is synthesized during glycolysis and the citric acid cycle. However, oxidative phosphorylation operates by a different mechanism. The structure of a mitochondrion is shown in Fig. 7.17. The protein complexes associated with the electron transport chain span the inner membrane and phosphorylation takes place in the intermembrane space. The Gibbs energy of the reactions Outer membrane Inner membrane Matrix Intermembrane space Fig. 7.17 The general features of a typical mitochondrion. 7.9 APPLICATIONS OF STANDARD POTENTIALS 229 in complexes I, III, and IV is first used to do the work of moving protons across the mitochondrial membrane. The complexes are oriented asymmetrically in the inner membrane so that the protons abstracted from one side of the membrane can be deposited on the other side. For example, the oxidation of NADH by Q in complex I is coupled to the transfer of four protons across the membrane. The coupling of electron transfer and proton pumping in complexes III and IV contribute further to a gradient of proton concentration across the membrane. Then the enzyme H+ -ATPase uses the energy stored in the proton gradient to phosphorylate ADP to ATP. Experiments show that 11 molecules of ATP are made for every three molecules of NADH and one molecule of FADH2 that are oxidized by the respiratory chain. The ATP is then hydrolysed on demand to perform useful biochemical work throughout the cell. The chemiosmotic theory proposed by Peter Mitchell explains how H+ -ATPases synthesize ATP from ADP. The energy stored in a transmembrane proton gradient come from two contributions. First, the difference in activity of H+ ion results in a difference in molar Gibbs energy across the mitochrondrial membrane ∆Gm,1 = Gm,in − Gm,out = RT ln Second, there is a membrane potential difference ∆φ = φin − φout that arises from differences in Coulombic interactions on each side of the membrane. The charge difference across a membrane per mole of H+ ions is NAe, or F, where F = eNA. It follows from Justification 7.3, that the molar Gibbs energy difference is then ∆Gm,2 = F∆φ. Adding this contribution to ∆Gm,1 gives the total Gibbs energy stored by the combination of an an activity gradient and a membrane potential gradient: ∆Gm = RT ln + F∆φ where we have replaced activities by molar concentrations. This equation also provides an estimate of the Gibbs energy available for phosphorylation of ADP. After using ln [H+ ] ≈ ln 10 × log [H+ ] and substituting ∆pH = pHin − pHout = −log [H+ ]in + log [H+ ]out, it follows that ∆Gm = F∆φ − (RT ln 10)∆pH In the mitochondrion, ∆pH ≈ −1.4 and ∆φ ≈ 0.14 V, so ∆Gm ≈ +21.5 kJ mol−1 . Because 31 kJ mol−1 is needed for phosphorylation, we conclude that at least 2 mol H+ (and probably more) must flow through the membrane for the phosphorylation of 1 mol ADP. (b) The determination of activity coefficients Once the standard potential of an electrode in a cell is known, we can use it to determine mean activity coefficients by measuring the cell emf with the ions at the concentration of interest. For example, the mean activity coefficient of the ions in hydrochloric acid of molality b is obtained from eqn 7.32 in the form ln γ± = − ln b {7.36} once E has been measured. (c) The determination of equilibrium constants The principal use for standard potentials is to calculate the standard emf of a cell formed from any two electrodes. To do so, we subtract the standard potential of the left-hand electrode from the standard potential of the right-hand electrode: E7 − E 2RT/F [H+ ]in [H+ ]out aH+ ,in aH+ ,out 230 7 CHEMICAL EQUILIBRIUM Silver/ silver chloride electrode Phosphate buffer solution Glass membrane Fig. 7.18 The glass electrode. It is commonly used in conjunction with a calomel electrode that makes contact with the test solution through a salt bridge. 50 mm Glass permeable to Li and Na ions + + Hydrated silica Inside Outside Fig. 7.19 A section through the wall of a glass electrode. E7 = E7 (right) − E7 (left) (7.37) Because ∆G7 = −νFE7 , it then follows that, if the result gives E 7 > 0, then the corresponding cell reaction has K > 1. Illustration 7.14 Calculating an equilibrium constant from standard potentials A disproportionation is a reaction in which a species is both oxidized and reduced. To study the disproportionation 2 Cu+ (aq) → Cu(s) + Cu2+ (aq) we combine the following electrodes: Right-hand electrode: Cu(s)|Cu+ (aq) Cu+ (aq) + e− → Cu(aq) E 7 = +0.52 V Left-hand electrode: Pt(s)|Cu2+ (aq),Cu+ (aq) Cu2+ (aq) + e− → Cu+ (s) E 7 = +0.16 V where the standard potentials are measured at 298 K. The standard emf of the cell is therefore E 7 = +0.52 V − 0.16 V = +0.36 V We can now calculate the equilibrium constant of the cell reaction. Because ν = 1, from eqn 7.30 ln K = = Hence, K = 1.2 × 106 . Self-test 7.11 Calculate the solubility constant (the equilibrium constant for the reaction Hg2Cl2(s) 5 Hg2 2+ (aq) + 2 Cl− (aq)) and the solubility of mercury(I) chloride at 298.15 K. Hint. The mercury(I) ion is the diatomic species Hg2 2+ . [2.6 × 10−18 , 8.7 × 10−7 mol kg−1 ] (d) Species-selective electrodes An ion-selective electrode is an electrode that generates a potential in response to the presence of a solution of specific ions. An example is the glass electrode (Fig. 7.18), which is sensitive to hydrogen ion activity, and has a potential proportional to pH. It is filled with a phosphate buffer containing Cl− ions, and conveniently has E = 0 when the external medium is at pH = 7. It is necessary to calibrate the glass electrode before use with solutions of known pH. The responsiveness of a glass electrode to the hydrogen ion activity is a result of complex processes at the interface between the glass membrane and the solutions on either side of it. The membrane itself is permeable to Na+ and Li+ ions but not to H+ ions. Therefore, the potential difference across the glass membrane must arise by a mechanism different from that responsible for biological transmembrane potentials (Impact on biochemistry 7.2). A clue to the mechanism comes from a detailed inspection of the glass membrane, for each face is coated with a thin layer of hydrated silica (Fig. 7.19). The hydrogen ions in the test solution modify this layer to an extent that depends on their activity in the solution, and the charge modification of the outside layer is transmitted to the inner layer by the Na+ and Li+ ions in the glass. The hydrogen ion activity gives rise to a membrane potential by this indirect mechanism. 0.36 0.025693 0.36 V 0.025693 V 7.9 APPLICATIONS OF STANDARD POTENTIALS 231 Electrodes sensitive to hydrogen ions, and hence to pH, are typically glasses based on lithium silicate doped with heavy-metal oxides. The glass can also be made responsive to Na+ , K+ , and NH4 + ions by being doped with Al2O3 and B2O3. A suitably adapted glass electrode can be used to detect the presence of certain gases. A simple form of a gas-sensing electrode consists of a glass electrode contained in an outer sleeve filled with an aqueous solution and separated from the test solution by a membrane that is permeable to gas. When a gas such as sulfur dioxide or ammonia diffuses into the aqueous solution, it modifies its pH, which in turn affects the potential of the glass electrode. The presence of an enzyme that converts a compound, such as urea or an amino acid, into ammonia, which then affects the pH, can be used to detect these organic compounds. Somewhat more sophisticated devices are used as ion-selective electrodes that give potentials according to the presence of specific ions present in a test solution. In one arrangement, a porous lipophilic (hydrocarbon-attracting) membrane is attached to a small reservoir of a hydrophobic (water-repelling) liquid, such as dioctylphenylphosphonate, that saturates it (Fig. 7.20). The liquid contains an agent, such as (RO)2PO2 − with R a C8 to C18 chain, that acts as a kind of solubilizing agent for the ions with which it can form a complex. The complex’s ions are able to migrate through the lipophilic membrane, and hence give rise to a transmembrane potential, which is detected by a silver/silver chloride electrode in the interior of the assembly. Electrodes of this construction can be designed to be sensitive to a variety of ionic species, including calcium, zinc, iron, lead, and copper ions. In theory, the transmembrane potential should be determined entirely by differences in the activity of the species that the electrode was designed to detect. In practice, a small potential difference, called the asymmetry potential, is observed even when the activity of the test species is the same on both sides of the membrane. The asymmetry potential is due to the fact that it is not possible to manufacture a membrane material that has the same structure and the same chemical properties throughout. Furthermore, all species-selective electrodes are sensitive to more than one species. For example, a Na+ selective electrode also responds, albeit less effectively, to the activity of K+ ions in the test solution. As a result of these effects, the potential of an electrode sensitive to species X+ that is also susceptible to interference by species Y+ is given by a modified form of the Nernst equation: E = Eap + β ln(aX+ + kX,YaY+) (7.38) where Eap is the asymmetry potential, β is an experimental parameter that captures deviations from the Nernst equation, and kX,Y is the selectivity coefficient of the electrode and is related to the response of the electrode to the interfering species Y+ . A value of β = 1 indicates that the electrode responds to the activity of ions in solution in a way that is consistent with the Nernst equation and, in practice, most speciesselective electrodes of high quality have β ≈ 1. The selectivity coefficient, and hence interference effects, can be minimized when designing and manufacturing a speciesselective electrode. For precise work, it is necessary to calibrate the response of the electrode by measuring Eap, β, and kX,Y before performing experiments on solutions of unknown concentration of X+ . (e) The determination of thermodynamic functions The standard emf of a cell is related to the standard reaction Gibbs energy through eqn 7.28 (∆rG7 = −νFE7 ). Therefore, by measuring E7 we can obtain this important thermodynamic quantity. Its value can then be used to calculate the Gibbs energy of formation of ions by using the convention explained in Section 3.6. RT F Porous lipophilic membrane Reservoir of hydrophobic liquid + chelating agent Silver/ silver chloride electrode Fig. 7.20 The structure of an ion-selective electrode. Chelated ions are able to migrate through the lipophilic membrane. 232 7 CHEMICAL EQUILIBRIUM Illustration 7.15 Determining the Gibbs energy of formation of an ion electrochemically The cell reaction taking place in Pt(s)|H2 |H+ (aq)||Ag+ (aq)|Ag(s) E 7 = +0.7996 V is Ag+ (aq) + 1 –2 H2(g) → H+ (aq) + Ag(s) ∆rG7 = −∆fG7 (Ag+ , aq) Therefore, with ν = 1, we find ∆fG7 (Ag+ , aq) = −(−FE7 ) = +77.15 kJ mol−1 which is in close agreement with the value in Table 2.6 of the Data section. The temperature coefficient of the standard cell emf, dE 7 /dT, gives the standard entropy of the cell reaction. This conclusion follows from the thermodynamic relation (∂G/∂T)p = −S and eqn 7.27, which combine to give = (7.39) The derivative is complete because E7 , like ∆rG7 , is independent of the pressure. Hence we have an electrochemical technique for obtaining standard reaction entropies and through them the entropies of ions in solution. Finally, we can combine the results obtained so far and use them to obtain the standard reaction enthalpy: ∆rH7 = ∆rG7 + T∆rS7 = −νF E7 − T (7.40) This expression provides a non-calorimetric method for measuring ∆rH7 and, through the convention ∆fH7 (H+ , aq) = 0, the standard enthalpies of formation of ions in solution (Section 2.8). Thus, electrical measurements can be used to calculate all the thermodynamic properties with which this chapter began. Example 7.5 Using the temperature coefficient of the cell potential The standard emf of the cell Pt(s)|H2(g)|HBr(aq)|AgBr(s)|Ag(s) was measured over a range of temperatures, and the data were fitted to the following polynomial: E 7 /V = 0.07131 − 4.99 × 10−4 (T/K − 298) − 3.45 × 10−6 (T/K − 298)2 Evaluate the standard reaction Gibbs energy, enthalpy, and entropy at 298 K. Method The standard Gibbs energy of reaction is obtained by using eqn 7.28 after evaluating E7 at 298 K and by using 1 V C = 1 J. The standard entropy of reaction is obtained by using eqn 7.39, which involves differentiating the polynomial with respect to T and then setting T = 298 K. The reaction enthalpy is obtained by combining the values of the standard Gibbs energy and entropy. Answer At T = 298 K, E 7 = +0.07131 V, so ∆rG7 = −νFE7 = −(1) × (9.6485 × 104 C mol−1 ) × (+0.07131 V) = −6.880 × 103 V C mol−1 = −6.880 kJ mol−1 D F dE7 dT A C ∆rS7 νF dE 7 dT CHECKLIST OF KEY IDEAS 233 Checklist of key ideas 1. The extent of reaction (ξ) is defined such that, when the extent of reaction changes by a finite amount ∆ξ, the amount of A present changes from nA,0 to nA,0 − ∆ξ. 2. The reaction Gibbs energy is the slope of the graph of the Gibbs energy plotted against the extent of reaction: ∆rG = (∂G/∂ξ)p,T; at equilibrium, ∆rG = 0. 3. An exergonic reaction is a reaction for which ∆rG < 0; such a reaction can be used to drive another process. An endergonic reaction is a reaction for which ∆rG > 0. 4. The general expression for ∆rG at an arbitrary stage of the reaction is ∆rG = ∆rG7 + RT ln Q. 5. The equilibrium constant (K) may be written in terms of ∆rG7 as ∆rG7 = −RT ln K. 6. The standard reaction Gibbs energy may be calculated from standard Gibbs energies of formation, ∆rG7 = ∑Productsν∆fG7 − ∑Reactantsν∆fG7 = ∑JνJ∆fG7 (J). 7. Thermodynamic equilibrium constant is an equilibrium constant K expressed in terms of activities (or fugacities): K = ΠJ aJ νJ equilibrium . D E F A B C 8. A catalyst does not affect the equilibrium constant. 9. Changes in pressure do not affect the equilibrium constant: (∂K/∂p)T = 0. However, partial pressures and concentrations can change in response to a change in pressure. 10. Le Chatelier’s principle states that a system at equilibrium, when subjected to a disturbance, responds in a way that tends to minimize the effect of the disturbance. 11. Increased temperature favours the reactants in exothermic reactions and the products in endothermic reactions. 12. The temperature dependence of the equilibrium constant is given by the van ‘t Hoff equation: d ln K/dT = ∆rH7 /RT2 . To calculate K at one temperature in terms of its value at another temperature, and provided ∆rH7 is independent of temperature, we use ln K2 − ln K1 = −(∆rH7 /R)(1/T2 − 1/T1). 13. A galvanic cell is an electrochemical cell that produces electricity as a result of the spontaneous reaction occurring inside it. An electrolytic cell is an electrochemical cell in which a non-spontaneous reaction is driven by an external source of current. 14. Oxidation is the removal of electrons from a species; reduction is the addition of electrons to a species; a redox The temperature coefficient of the cell potential is = −4.99 × 10−4 V K−1 − 2(3.45 × 10−6 )(T/K − 298) V K−1 At T = 298 K this expression evaluates to = −4.99 × 10−4 V K−1 So, from eqn 7.39, the reaction entropy is ∆rS7 = 1 × (9.6485 × 104 C mol−1 ) × (−4.99 × 10−4 V K−1 ) = −48.2 J K−1 mol−1 It then follows that ∆rH7 = ∆rG7 + T∆rS7 = −6.880 kJ mol−1 + (298 K) × (−0.0482 kJ K−1 mol−1 ) = −21.2 kJ mol−1 One difficulty with this procedure lies in the accurate measurement of small temperature coefficients of cell potential. Nevertheless, it is another example of the striking ability of thermodynamics to relate the apparently unrelated, in this case to relate electrical measurements to thermal properties. Self-test 7.12 Predict the standard potential of the Harned cell at 303 K from tables of thermodynamic data. [+0.2222 V] dE dT dE7 dT 234 7 CHEMICAL EQUILIBRIUM reaction is a reaction in which there is a transfer of electrons from one species to another. 15. The anode is the electrode at which oxidation occurs. The cathode is the electrode at which reduction occurs. 16. The electromotive force (emf) is the cell potential when it is balanced by an exactly opposing source of potential so that the cell reaction occurs reversibly, the composition is constant, and no current flows. 17. The cell potential and the reaction Gibbs energy are related by −νFE = ∆rG. 18. The standard emf is the standard reaction Gibbs energy expressed as a potential: E7 = ∆rG7 /νF. 19. The Nernst equation is the equation for the emf of a cell in terms of the composition: E = E7 − (RT/νF) ln Q. 20. The equilibrium constant for a cell reaction is related to the standard emf by ln K = νFE7 /RT. 21. The standard potential of a couple (E7 ) is the standard emf of a cell in which a couple forms the right-hand electrode and the standard hydrogen electrode is the left-hand electrode. 22. To calculate the standard emf, form the difference of electrode potentials: E 7 = E7 (right) − E 7 (left). 23. The temperature coefficient of cell potential is given by dE7 /dT = ∆rS7 /νF. 24. The standard reaction entropy and enthalpy are calculated from the temperature dependence of the standard emf by: ∆rS7 = νFdE 7 /dT, ∆rH7 = −ν(FE7 − TdE7 /dT). Further reading Articles and texts P.W. Atkins and J.C. de Paula, Physical chemistry for the life sciences. W.H. Freeman and Company, New York (2005). A.J. Bard and L.R. Faulkner, Electrochemical methods. Wiley, New York (2000). M.J. Blandamer, Chemical equilibria in solution. Ellis Horwood/Prentice Hall, Hemel Hempstead (1992). W.A. Cramer and D.A. Knaff, Energy transduction in biological membranes, a textbook of bioenergetics. Springer–Verlag, New York (1990). D.R. Crow, Principles and applications of electrochemistry. Blackie, London (1994). K. Denbigh, The principles of chemical equilibrium, with applications in chemistry and chemical engineering. Cambridge University Press (1981). C.H. Hamann, A. Hamnett, and W. Vielstich, Electrochemistry. Wiley-VCH, Weinheim (1998). Sources of data and information M.S. Antelman, The encyclopedia of chemical electrode potentials, Plenum, New York (1982). A.J. Bard, R. Parsons, and J. Jordan (ed.), Standard potentials in aqueous solution. Marcel Dekker, New York (1985). R.N. Goldberg and Y.B. Tewari, Thermodynamics of enzymecatalyzed reactions. J. Phys. Chem. Ref. Data. Part 1: 22, 515 (1993). Part 2: 23, 547 (1994). Part 3: 23, 1035 (1994). Part 4: 24, 1669 (1995). Part 5: 24, 1765 (1995). Discussion questions 7.1 Explain how the mixing of reactants and products affects the position of chemical equilibrium. 7.2 Suggest how the thermodynamic equilibrium constant may respond differently to changes in pressure and temperature from the equilibrium constant expressed in terms of partial pressures. 7.3 Account for Le Chatelier’s principle in terms of thermodynamic quantities. 7.4 Explain the molecular basis of the van ’t Hoff equation for the temperature dependence of K. 7.5 (a) How may an Ellingham diagram be used to decide whether one metal may be used to reduce the oxide of another metal? (b) Use the Ellingham diagram in Fig. 7.10 to identify the lowest temperature at which zinc oxide can be reduced to zinc metal by carbon. 7.6 Distinguish between cell potential and electromotive force and explain why the latter is related to thermodynamic quantities. 7.7 Describe the contributions to the emf of cells formed by combining the electrodes specified in Table 7.1. 7.8 Describe a method for the determination of a standard potential of a redox couple. 7.9 Devise a method for the determination of the pH of an aqueous solution. EXERCISES 235 Exercises 7.1(a) At 2257 K and 1.00 atm total pressure, water is 1.77 per cent dissociated at equilibrium by way of the reaction 2 H2O(g) 5 2 H2(g) + O2(g). Calculate (a) K, (b) ∆rG7 , and (c) ∆rG at this temperature. 7.1(b) For the equilibrium, N2O4(g) 5 2 NO2(g), the degree of dissociation, αe, at 298 K is 0.201 at 1.00 bar total pressure. Calculate (a) ∆rG, (2) K, and (3) ∆rG7 at 298 K. 7.2(a) Dinitrogen tetroxide is 18.46 per cent dissociated at 25°C and 1.00 bar in the equilibrium N2O4(g) 5 2 NO2(g). Calculate (a) K at 25°C, (b) ∆rG7 , (c) K at 100°C given that ∆rH7 = +57.2 kJ mol−1 over the temperature range. 7.2(b) Molecular bromine is 24 per cent dissociated at 1600 K and 1.00 bar in the equilibrium Br2(g) 5 2 Br(g). Calculate (a) K at 25°C, (b) ∆rG7 , (c) K at 2000°C given that ∆rH7 = +112 kJ mol−1 over the temperature range. 7.3(a) From information in the Data section, calculate the standard Gibbs energy and the equilibrium constant at (a) 298 K and (b) 400 K for the reaction PbO(s) + CO(g) 5 Pb(s) + CO2(g). Assume that the reaction enthalpy is independent of temperature. 7.3(b) From information in the Data section, calculate the standard Gibbs energy and the equilibrium constant at (a) 25°C and (b) 50°C for the reaction CH4(g) + 3 Cl2(g) 5 CHCl3(l) + 3 HCl(g). Assume that the reaction enthalpy is independent of temperature. 7.4(a) In the gas-phase reaction 2 A + B 5 3 C + 2 D, it was found that, when 1.00 mol A, 2.00 mol B, and 1.00 mol D were mixed and allowed to come to equilibrium at 25°C, the resulting mixture contained 0.90 mol C at a total pressure of 1.00 bar. Calculate (a) the mole fractions of each species at equilibrium, (b) Kx, (c) K, and (d) ∆rG7 . 7.4(b) In the gas-phase reaction A + B 5 C + 2 D, it was found that, when 2.00 mol A, 1.00 mol B, and 3.00 mol D were mixed and allowed to come to equilibrium at 25°C, the resulting mixture contained 0.79 mol C at a total pressure of 1.00 bar. Calculate (a) the mole fractions of each species at equilibrium, (b) Kx, (c) K, and (d) ∆rG7 . 7.5(a) The standard reaction enthalpy of Zn(s) + H2O(g) → ZnO(s) + H2(g) is approximately constant at +224 kJ mol−1 from 920 K up to 1280 K. The standard reaction Gibbs energy is +33 kJ mol−1 at 1280 K. Estimate the temperature at which the equilibrium constant becomes greater than 1. 7.5(b) The standard enthalpy of a certain reaction is approximately constant at +125 kJ mol−1 from 800 K up to 1500 K. The standard reaction Gibbs energy is +22 kJ mol−1 at 1120 K. Estimate the temperature at which the equilibrium constant becomes greater than 1. 7.6(a) The equilibrium constant of the reaction 2 C3H6(g) 5 C2H4(g) + C4H8(g) is found to fit the expression ln K = A + B/T + C/T2 between 300 K and 600 K, with A = −1.04, B = −1088 K, and C = 1.51 × 105 K2 . Calculate the standard reaction enthalpy and standard reaction entropy at 400 K. 7.6(b) The equilibrium constant of a reaction is found to fit the expression ln K = A + B/T + C/T3 between 400 K and 500 K with A = −2.04, B = −1176 K, and C = 2.1 × 107 K3 . Calculate the standard reaction enthalpy and standard reaction entropy at 450 K. 7.7(a) The standard reaction Gibbs energy of the isomerization of borneol (C10H17OH) to isoborneol in the gas phase at 503 K is +9.4 kJ mol−1 . Calculate the reaction Gibbs energy in a mixture consisting of 0.15 mol of borneol and 0.30 mol of isoborneol when the total pressure is 600 Torr. 7.7(b) The equilibrium pressure of H2 over solid uranium and uranium hydride, UH3, at 500 K is 139 Pa. Calculate the standard Gibbs energy of formation of UH3(s) at 500 K. 7.8(a) Calculate the percentage change in Kx for the reaction H2CO(g) 5 CO(g) + H2(g) when the total pressure is increased from 1.0 bar to 2.0 bar at constant temperature. 7.8(b) Calculate the percentage change in Kx for the reaction CH3OH(g) + NOCl(g) 5 HCl(g) + CH3NO2(g) when the total pressure is increased from 1.0 bar to 2.0 bar at constant temperature. 7.9(a) The equilibrium constant for the gas-phase isomerization of borneol (C10H17OH) to isoborneol at 503 K is 0.106. A mixture consisting of 7.50 g of borneol and 14.0 g of isoborneol in a container of volume 5.0 dm3 is heated to 503 K and allowed to come to equilibrium. Calculate the mole fractions of the two substances at equilibrium. 7.9(b) The equilibrium constant for the reaction N2(g) + O2(g) 5 2 NO(g) is 1.69 × 10−3 at 2300 K. A mixture consisting of 5.0 g of nitrogen and 2.0 g of oxygen in a container of volume 1.0 dm3 is heated to 2300 K and allowed to come to equilibrium. Calculate the mole fraction of NO at equilibrium. 7.10(a) What is the standard enthalpy of a reaction for which the equilibrium constant is (a) doubled, (b) halved when the temperature is increased by 10 K at 298 K? 7.10(b) What is the standard enthalpy of a reaction for which the equilibrium constant is (a) doubled, (b) halved when the temperature is increased by 15 K at 310 K? 7.11(a) The standard Gibbs energy of formation of NH3(g) is −16.5 kJ mol−1 at 298 K. What is the reaction Gibbs energy when the partial pressures of the N2, H2, and NH3 (treated as perfect gases) are 3.0 bar, 1.0 bar, and 4.0 bar, respectively? What is the spontaneous direction of the reaction in this case? 7.11(b) The dissociation vapour pressure of NH4Cl at 427°C is 608 kPa but at 459°C it has risen to 1115 kPa. Calculate (a) the equilibrium constant, (b) the standard reaction Gibbs energy, (c) the standard enthalpy, (d) the standard entropy of dissociation, all at 427°C. Assume that the vapour behaves as a perfect gas and that ∆H7 and ∆S7 are independent of temperature in the range given. 7.12(a) Estimate the temperature at which CaCO3(calcite) decomposes. 7.12(b) Estimate the temperature at which CuSO4·5H2O undergoes dehydration. 7.13(a) For CaF2(s) 5 Ca2+ (aq) + 2 F− (aq), K = 3.9 ×10−11 at 25°C and the standard Gibbs energy of formation of CaF2(s) is −1167 kJ mol−1 . Calculate the standard Gibbs energy of formation of CaF2(aq). 7.13(b) For PbI2(s) 5 Pb2+ (aq) + 2 I− (aq), K = 1.4 × 10−8 at 25°C and the standard Gibbs energy of formation of PbI2(s) is −173.64 kJ mol−1 . Calculate the standard Gibbs energy of formation of PbI2(aq). 7.14(a) Write the cell reaction and electrode half-reactions and calculate the standard emf of each of the following cells: (a) Zn|ZnSO4(aq)||AgNO3(aq)|Ag (b) Cd|CdCl2(aq)||HNO3(aq)|H2(g)|Pt (c) Pt|K3[Fe(CN)6](aq),K4[Fe(CN)6](aq)||CrCl3(aq)|Cr 7.14(b) Write the cell reaction and electrode half-reactions and calculate the standard emf of each the following cells: (a) Pt|Cl2(g)|HCl(aq)||K2CrO4(aq)|Ag2CrO4(s)|Ag (b) Pt|Fe3+ (aq),Fe2+ (aq)||Sn4+ (aq),Sn2+ (aq)|Pt (c) Cu|Cu2+ (aq)||Mn2+ (aq),H+ (aq)|MnO2(s)|Pt 236 7 CHEMICAL EQUILIBRIUM 7.15(a) Devise cells in which the following are the reactions and calculate the standard emf in each case: (a) Zn(s) + CuSO4(aq) → ZnSO4(aq) + Cu(s) (b) 2 AgCl(s) + H2(g) → 2 HCl(aq) + 2 Ag(s) (c) 2 H2(g) + O2(g) → 2 H2O(l) 7.15(b) Devise cells in which the following are the reactions and calculate the standard emf in each case: (a) 2 Na(s) + 2 H2O(l) → 2 NaOH(aq) + H2(g) (b) H2(g) + I2(g) → 2 HI(aq) (c) H3O+ (aq) + OH− (aq) → 2 H2O(l) 7.16(a) Use the Debye–Hückel limiting law and the Nernst equation to estimate the potential of the cell Ag|AgBr(s)|KBr(aq, 0.050 mol kg−1 ) ||Cd(NO3)2(aq, 0.010 mol kg−1 )|Cd at 25°C. 7.16(b) Consider the cell Pt|H2(g,p7 )| HCl(aq)|AgCl(s)| Ag, for which the cell reaction is 2 AgCl(s) + H2(g) → 2 Ag(s) + 2 HCl(aq). At 25°C and a molality of HCl of 0.010 mol kg−1 , E = +0.4658 V. (a) Write the Nernst equation for the cell reaction. (b) Calculate ∆rG for the cell reaction. (c) Assuming that the Debye–Hückel limiting law holds at this concentration, calculate E7 (AgCl, Ag). 7.17(a) Calculate the equilibrium constants of the following reactions at 25°C from standard potential data: (a) Sn(s) + Sn4+ (aq) 5 2 Sn2+ (aq) (b) Sn(s) + 2 AgCl(s) 5 SnCl2(aq) + 2 Ag(s) 7.17(b) Calculate the equilibrium constants of the following reactions at 25°C from standard potential data: (a) Sn(s) + CuSO4(aq) 5 Cu(s) + SnSO4(aq) (b) Cu2+ (aq) + Cu(s) 5 2 Cu+ (aq) 7.18(a) The emf of the cell Ag|AgI(s)|AgI(aq)|Ag is +0.9509 V at 25°C. Calculate (a) the solubility product of AgI and (b) its solubility. 7.18(b) The emf of the cell Bi|Bi2S3(s)|Bi2S3(aq)|Bi is −0.96 V at 25°C. Calculate (a) the solubility product of Bi2S3 and (b) its solubility. Problems* Numerical problems 7.1 The equilibrium constant for the reaction, I2(s) + Br2(g) 5 2 IBr(g) is 0.164 at 25°C. (a) Calculate ∆rG7 for this reaction. (b) Bromine gas is introduced into a container with excess solid iodine. The pressure and temperature are held at 0.164 atm and 25°C, respectively. Find the partial pressure of IBr(g) at equilibrium. Assume that all the bromine is in the liquid form and that the vapour pressure of iodine is negligible. (c) In fact, solid iodine has a measurable vapour pressure at 25°C. In this case, how would the calculation have to be modified? 7.2 Consider the dissociation of methane, CH4(g), into the elements H2(g) and C(s, graphite). (a) Given that ∆fH7 (CH4, g) = −74.85 kJ mol−1 and that ∆fS7 (CH4, g) = −80.67 J K−1 mol−1 at 298 K, calculate the value of the equilibrium constant at 298 K. (b) Assuming that ∆fH7 is independent of temperature, calculate K at 50°C. (c) Calculate the degree of dissociation, αe, of methane at 25°C and a total pressure of 0.010 bar. (d) Without doing any numerical calculations, explain how the degree of dissociation for this reaction will change as the pressure and temperature are varied. 7.3 The equilibrium pressure of H2 over U(s) and UH3(s) between 450 K and 715 K fits the expression ln(p/Pa) = A + B/T + C ln(T/K), with A = 69.32, B = −1.464 × 104 K, and C = −5.65. Find an expression for the standard enthalpy of formation of UH3(s) and from it calculate ∆rCp 7 . 7.4 The degree of dissociation, αe, of CO2(g) into CO(g) and O2(g) at high temperatures was found to vary with temperature as follows: T/K 1395 1443 1498 αe/10−4 1.44 2.50 4.71 Assuming ∆rH7 to be constant over this temperature range, calculate K, ∆rG7 , ∆rH7 , and ∆rS7 . Make any justifiable approximations. 7.5 The standard reaction enthalpy for the decomposition of CaCl2·NH3(s) into CaCl2(s) and NH3(g) is nearly constant at +78 kJ mol−1 between 350 K and 470 K. The equilibrium pressure of NH3 in the presence of CaCl2·NH3 is 1.71 kPa at 400 K. Find an expression for the temperature dependence of ∆rG7 in the same range. 7.6 Calculate the equilibrium constant of the reaction CO(g) + H2(g) 5 H2CO(g) given that, for the production of liquid formaldehyde, ∆rG7 = +28.95 kJ mol−1 at 298 K and that the vapour pressure of formaldehyde is 1500 Torr at that temperature. 7.7 Acetic acid was evaporated in container of volume 21.45 cm3 at 437 K and at an external pressure of 101.9 kPa, and the container was then sealed. The mass of acid present in the sealed container was 0.0519 g. The experiment was repeated with the same container but at 471 K, and it was found that 0.0380 g of acetic acid was present. Calculate the equilibrium constant for the dimerization of the acid in the vapour and the enthalpy of vaporization. 7.8 A sealed container was filled with 0.300 mol H2(g), 0.400 mol I2(g), and 0.200 mol HI(g) at 870 K and total pressure 1.00 bar. Calculate the amounts of the components in the mixture at equilibrium given that K = 870 for the reaction H2(g) + I2(g) 5 2 HI(g). 7.9 The dissociation of I2 can be monitored by measuring the total pressure, and three sets of results are as follows: T/K 973 1073 1173 100p/atm 6.244 7.500 9.181 104 nI 2.4709 2.4555 2.4366 where nI is the amount of I atoms per mole of I2 molecules in the mixture, which occupied 342.68 cm3 . Calculate the equilibrium constants of the dissociation and the standard enthalpy of dissociation at the mean temperature. 7.10‡ Thorn et al. carried out a study of Cl2O(g) by photoelectron ionization (R.P. Thorn, L.J. Stief, S.-C. Kuo, and R.B. Klemm, J. Phys. Chem. 100, 14178 (1996)). From their measurements, they report ∆fH7 (Cl2O) = +77.2 kJ mol−1 . They combined this measurement with literature data on the reaction Cl2O (g) + H2O(g)→ 2 HOCl(g), for which K = 8.2 × 10−2 and ∆rS7 = * Problems denoted with the symbol ‡ were supplied by Charles Trapp, Carmen Giunta, and Marshall Cady. PROBLEMS 237 +16.38 J K−1 mol−1 , and with readily available thermodynamic data on water vapour to report a value for ∆fH7 (HOCl). Calculate that value. All quantities refer to 298 K. 7.11‡ The 1980s saw reports of ∆fH7 (SiH2) ranging from 243 to 289 kJ mol−1 . For example, the lower value was cited in the review article by R. Walsh (Acc. Chem. Res. 14, 246 (1981)); Walsh later leant towards the upper end of the range (H.M. Frey, R. Walsh, and I.M. Watts, J. Chem. Soc., Chem. Commun. 1189 (1986)). The higher value was reported in S.-K. Shin and J.L. Beauchamp, J. Phys. Chem. 90, 1507 (1986). If the standard enthalpy of formation is uncertain by this amount, by what factor is the equilibrium constant for the formation of SiH2 from its elements uncertain at (a) 298 K, (b) 700 K? 7.12 Fuel cells provide electrical power for spacecraft (as in the NASA space shuttles) and also show promise as power sources for automobiles. Hydrogen and carbon monoxide have been investigated for use in fuel cells, so their solubilities in molten salts are of interest. Their solubilities in a molten NaNO3/KNO3 mixture were examined (E. Desimoni and P.G. Zambonin, J. Chem. Soc. Faraday Trans. 1, 2014 (1973)) with the following results: log sH2 = −5.39 − log sCO = −5.98 − where s is the solubility in mol cm−3 bar−1 . Calculate the standard molar enthalpies of solution of the two gases at 570 K. 7.13 Given that ∆rG7 = −212.7 kJ mol−1 for the reaction in the Daniell cell at 25°C, and b(CuSO4) = 1.0 × 10−3 mol kg−1 and b(ZnSO4) = 3.0 × 10−3 mol kg−1 , calculate (a) the ionic strengths of the solutions, (b) the mean ionic activity coefficients in the compartments, (c) the reaction quotient, (d) the standard cell potential, and (e) the cell potential. (Take γ+ = γ− = γ± in the respective compartments.) 7.14 A fuel cell develops an electric potential from the chemical reaction between reagents supplied from an outside source. What is the emf of a cell fuelled by (a) hydrogen and oxygen, (b) the combustion of butane at 1.0 bar and 298 K? 7.15 Although the hydrogen electrode may be conceptually the simplest electrode and is the basis for our reference state of electrical potential in electrochemical systems, it is cumbersome to use. Therefore, several substitutes for it have been devised. One of these alternatives is the quinhydrone electrode (quinhydrone, Q·QH2, is a complex of quinone, C6H4O2 = Q, and hydroquinone, C6H4O2H2 = QH2). The electrode half–reaction is Q(aq) + 2 H+ (aq) + 2 e− → QH2(aq), E7 = +0.6994 V. If the cell Hg|Hg2Cl2(s)|HCl(aq)|Q· QH2 |Au is prepared, and the measured cell potential is +0.190 V, what is the pH of the HCl solution? Assume that the Debye–Hückel limiting law is applicable. 7.16 Consider the cell, Zn(s)|ZnCl2 (0.0050 mol kg−1 )|Hg2Cl2(s) Hg(l), for which the cell reaction is Hg2Cl2(s) + Zn(s) → 2 Hg(l) + 2 Cl− (aq) + Zn2+ (aq). Given that E7 (Zn2+ ,Zn) = −0.7628 V, E 7 (Hg2Cl2, Hg) = +0.2676 V, and that the emf is +1.2272 V, (a) write the Nernst equation for the cell. Determine (b) the standard emf, (c) ∆rG, ∆rG7 , and K for the cell reaction, (d) the mean ionic activity and activity coefficient of ZnCl2 from the measured cell potential, and (e) the mean ionic activity coefficient of ZnCl2 from the Debye–Hückel limiting law. (f) Given that (∂E/∂T)p = −4.52 × 10−4 V K−1 . Calculate ∆S and ∆H. 7.17 The emf of the cell Pt|H2(g, p7 )| HCl(aq,b)| Hg2Cl2(s)|Hg(l) has been measured with high precision (G.J. Hills and D.J.G. Ives, J. Chem. Soc., 311 (1951)) with the following results at 25°C: b/(mmol kg−1 ) 1.6077 3.0769 5.0403 7.6938 10.9474 E/V 0.60080 0.56825 0.54366 0.52267 0.50532 980 T/K 980 T/K Determine the standard emf of the cell and the mean activity coefficient of HCl at these molalities. (Make a least-squares fit of the data to the best straight line.) 7.18 Careful measurements of the emf of the cell Pt|H2(g, p7 )|NaOH(aq, 0.0100 mol kg−1 ), NaCl(aq, 0.01125 mol kg−1 )|AgCl(s)|Ag have been reported (C.P. Bezboruah, M.F.G.F.C. Camoes, A.K. Covington, and J.V. Dobson, J. Chem. Soc. Faraday Trans. I 69, 949 (1973)). Among the data is the following information: θ/°C 20.0 25.0 30.0 E/V 1.04774 1.04864 1.04942 Calculate pKw at these temperatures and the standard enthalpy and entropy of the autoprotolysis of water at 25.0°C. 7.19 Measurements of the emf of cells of the type Ag|AgX(s)MX(b1)|Mx Hg|MX(b2)|AgX(s)|Ag, where MxHg denotes an amalgam and the electrolyte is an alkali metal halide dissolved in ethylene glycol, have been reported (U. Sen, J. Chem. Soc. Faraday Trans. I 69, 2006 (1973)) and some values for LiCl are given below. Estimate the activity coefficient at the concentration marked * and then use this value to calculate activity coefficients from the measured cell potential at the other concentrations. Base your answer on the following version of the extended Debye–Hückel law: log γ = − + kI with A = 1.461, B = 1.70, k = 0.20, and I = b/b7 . For b2 = 0.09141 mol kg−1 : b1/(mol kg−1 ) 0.0555 0.09141* 0.1652 0.2171 1.040 1.350 E/V −0.0220 0.0000 0.0263 0.0379 0.1156 0.1336 7.20 The standard potential of the AgCl/Ag,Cl− couple has been measured very carefully over a range of temperature (R.G. Bates and V.E. Bowers, J. Res. Nat. Bur. Stand. 53, 283 (1954)) and the results were found to fit the expression E7 /V = 0.23659 − 4.8564 × 10−4 (θ/°C) − 3.4205 × 10−6 (θ/°C)2 + 5.869 × 10−9 (θ/°C)3 Calculate the standard Gibbs energy and enthalpy of formation of Cl− (aq) and its entropy at 298 K. 7.21‡ (a) Derive a general relation for (∂E/∂p)T,n for electrochemical cells employing reactants in any state of matter. (b) E. Cohen and K. Piepenbroek (Z. Physik. Chem. 167A, 365 (1933)) calculated the change in volume for the reaction TlCl(s) + CNS− (aq) → TlCNS(s) + Cl− (aq) at 30°C from density data and obtained ∆rV = −2.666 ± 0.080 cm3 mol−1 . They also measured the emf of the cell Tl(Hg)|TlCNS(s)|KCNSӇKCl|TlCl|Tl(Hg) at pressures up to 1500 atm. Their results are given in the following table: p/atm 1.00 250 500 750 1000 1250 1500 E/mV 8.56 9.27 9.98 10.69 11.39 12.11 12.82 From this information, obtain (∂E/∂p)T,n at 30°C and compare to the value obtained from ∆rV. (c) Fit the data to a polynomial for E against p. How constant is (∂E/∂p)T,n? (d) From the polynomial, estimate an effective isothermal compressibility for the cell as a whole. 7.22‡ The table below summarizes the emf observed for the cell Pd|H2(g, 1 bar)|BH(aq, b), B(aq, b)|AgCl(s)|Ag. Each measurement is made at equimolar concentrations of 2-aminopyridinium chloride (BH) and 2-aminopyridine (B). The data are for 25°C and it is found that E7 = 0.22251 V. Use the data to determine pKa for the acid at 25°C and the mean activity coefficient (γ±) of BH as a function of molality (b) and ionic strength (I). Use the extended Debye–Hückel equation for the mean activity coefficient in the form −log γ± = − kb AI1/2 1 + BI1/2 AI1/2 1 − BI1/2 238 7 CHEMICAL EQUILIBRIUM where A = 0.5091 and B and k are parameters that depend upon the ions. Draw a graph of the mean activity coefficient with b = 0.04 mol kg−1 and 0 ≤ I ≤ 0.1. b/(mol kg−1 ) 0.01 0.02 0.03 0.04 0.05 E(25°C)/V 0.74452 0.72853 0.71928 0.71314 0.70809 b/(mol kg−1 ) 0.06 0.07 0.08 0.09 0.10 E(25°C)/V 0.70380 0.70059 0.69790 0.69571 0.69338 Hint. Use mathematical software or a spreadsheet. 7.23 Superheavy elements are now of considerable interest, particularly because signs of stability are starting to emerge with element 114, which has recently been made. Shortly before it was (falsely) believed that the first superheavy element had been discovered, an attempt was made to predict the chemical properties of ununpentium (Uup, element 115, O.L. Keller, C.W. Nestor, and B. Fricke, J. Phys. Chem. 78, 1945 (1974)). In one part of the paper the standard enthalpy and entropy of the reaction Uup+ (aq) + 1 –2H2(g) → Uup(s) + H+ (aq) were estimated from the following data: ∆subH7 (Uup) = +1.5 eV, I(Uup) = 5.52 eV, ∆hydH7 (Uup+ , aq) = −3.22 eV, S7 (Uup+ , aq) = +1.34 meV K−1 , S7 (Uup, s) = 0.69 meV K−1 . Estimate the expected standard potential of the Uup+ /Uup couple. 7.24 Sodium fluoride is routinely added to public water supplies because it is known that fluoride ion can prevent tooth decay. In a fluoride-selective electrode used in the analysis of water samples a crystal of LaF3 doped with Eu2+ , denoted asEu2+ :LaF3, provides a semipermeable barrier between the test solution and the solution inside the electrode (the filling solution), which contains 0.1 mol kg−1 NaF(aq) and 0.1 mol kg−1 NaCl(aq). A silver–silver chloride electrode immersed in the filling solution is connected to a potentiometer and the emf of the cell can be measured against an appropriate reference electrode. It follows that the half-cell for a fluoride-selective electrode is represented by Ag(s) |AgCl(s)|NaCl(aq, b1), NaF (aq, b1)|Eu2+ :LaF3 (s)|F− (aq, b2) where b1 and b2 are the molalities of fluoride ion in the filling and test solutions, respectively. (a) Derive an expression for the emf of this half-cell. (b) The fluoride-selective electrode just described is not sensitive to HF(aq). Hydroxide ion is the only interfering species, with kF− ,OH− = 0.1. Use this information and the fact that Ka of HF is 3.5 × 10−4 at 298 K to specify a range of pH values in which the electrode responds accurately to the activity of F− in the test solution at 298 K. Theoretical problems 7.25 Express the equilibrium constant of a gas-phase reaction A + 3 B 5 2 C in terms of the equilibrium value of the extent of reaction, ξ, given that initially A and B were present in stoichiometric proportions. Find an expression for ξ as a function of the total pressure, p, of the reaction mixture and sketch a graph of the expression obtained. 7.26 Find an expression for the standard reaction Gibbs energy at a temperature T′ in terms of its value at another temperature T and the coefficients a, b, and c in the expression for the molar heat capacity listed in Table 2.2. Evaluate the standard Gibbs energy of formation of H2O(l) at 372 K from its value at 298 K. 7.27 Show that, if the ionic strength of a solution of the sparingly soluble salt MX and the freely soluble salt NX is dominated by the concentration C of the latter, and if it is valid to use the Debye–Hückel limiting law, the solubility S′ in the mixed solution is given by S′ = when Ks is small (in a sense to be specified). Kse4.606AC1/2 C Applications: to biology, environmental science, and chemical engineering 7.28 Here we investigate the molecular basis for the observation that the hydrolysis of ATP is exergonic at pH = 7.0 and 310 K. (a) It is thought that the exergonicity of ATP hydrolysis is due in part to the fact that the standard entropies of hydrolysis of polyphosphates are positive. Why would an increase in entropy accompany the hydrolysis of a triphosphate group into a diphosphate and a phosphate group? (b) Under identical conditions, the Gibbs energies of hydrolysis of H4ATP and MgATP2− , a complex between the Mg2+ ion and ATP4− , are less negative than the Gibbs energy of hydrolysis of ATP4− . This observation has been used to support the hypothesis that electrostatic repulsion between adjacent phosphate groups is a factor that controls the exergonicity of ATP hydrolysis. Provide a rationale for the hypothesis and discuss how the experimental evidence supports it. Do these electrostatic effects contribute to the ∆rH or ∆rS terms that determine the exergonicity of the reaction? Hint. In the MgATP2− complex, the Mg2+ ion and ATP4− anion form two bonds: one that involves a negatively charged oxygen belonging to the terminal phosphate group of ATP4− and another that involves a negatively charged oxygen belonging to the phosphate group adjacent to the terminal phosphate group of ATP4− . 7.29 To get a sense of the effect of cellular conditions on the ability of ATP to drive biochemical processes, compare the standard Gibbs energy of hydrolysis of ATP to ADP with the reaction Gibbs energy in an environment at 37°C in which pH = 7.0 and the ATP, ADP, and Pi − concentrations are all 1.0 µmol dm−3 . 7.30 Under biochemical standard conditions, aerobic respiration produces approximately 38 molecules of ATP per molecule of glucose that is completely oxidized. (a) What is the percentage efficiency of aerobic respiration under biochemical standard conditions? (b) The following conditions are more likely to be observed in a living cell: pCO2 = 5.3 × 10−2 atm, pO2 = 0.132 atm, [glucose] = 5.6 ×10−2 mol dm−3 , [ATP] = [ADP] = [Pi] = 1.0 × 10−4 mol dm−3 , pH = 7.4, T = 310 K. Assuming that activities can be replaced by the numerical values of molar concentrations, calculate the efficiency of aerobic respiration under these physiological conditions. (c) A typical diesel engine operates between Tc = 873 K and Th = 1923 K with an efficiency that is approximately 75 per cent of the theoretical limit of (1 − Tc/Th) (see Section 3.2). Compare the efficiency of a typical diesel engine with that of aerobic respiration under typical physiological conditions (see part b). Why is biological energy conversion more or less efficient than energy conversion in a diesel engine? 7.31 In anaerobic bacteria, the source of carbon may be a molecule other than glucose and the final electron acceptor is some molecule other than O2. Could a bacterium evolve to use the ethanol/nitrate pair instead of the glucose/O2 pair as a source of metabolic energy? 7.32 If the mitochondrial electric potential between matrix and the intermembrane space were 70 mV, as is common for other membranes, how much ATP could be synthesized from the transport of 4 mol H+ , assuming the pH difference remains the same? 7.33 The standard potentials of proteins are not commonly measured by the methods described in this chapter because proteins often lose their native structure and function when they react on the surfaces of electrodes. In an alternative method, the oxidized protein is allowed to react with an appropriate electron donor in solution. The standard potential of the protein is then determined from the Nernst equation, the equilibrium concentrations of all species in solution, and the known standard potential of the electron donor. We shall illustrate this method with the protein cytochrome c. The one-electron reaction between cytochrome c, cyt, and 2,6-dichloroindophenol, D, can be followed spectrophotometrically because each of the four species in solution has a distinct colour, or absorption spectrum. We write the reaction as cytox + Dred 5 cytred + Dox, where the PROBLEMS 239 subscripts ‘ox’ and ‘red’ refer to oxidized and reduced states, respectively. (a) Consider E 7 cyt and E7 D to be the standard potentials of cytochrome c and D, respectively. Show that, at equilibrium (‘eq’), a plot of ln([Dox]eq/[Dred]eq) versus ln([cytox]eq/[cytred]eq) is linear with slope of 1 and y-intercept F(E7 cyt − E7 D)/RT, where equilibrium activities are replaced by the numerical values of equilibrium molar concentrations. (b) The following data were obtained for the reaction between oxidized cytochrome c and reduced D in a pH 6.5 buffer at 298 K. The ratios [Dox]eq/[Dred]eq and [cytox]eq/[cytred]eq were adjusted by titrating a solution containing oxidized cytochrome c and reduced D with a solution of sodium ascorbate, which is a strong reductant. From the data and the standard potential of D of 0.237 V, determine the standard potential cytochrome c at pH 6.5 and 298K. [Dox]eq/[Dred]eq 0.00279 0.00843 0.0257 0.0497 0.0748 0.238 0.534 [cytox]eq/[cytred]eq 0.0106 0.0230 0.0894 0.197 0.335 0.809 1.39 7.34‡ The dimerization of ClO in the Antarctic winter stratosphere is believed to play an important part in that region’s severe seasonal depletion of ozone. The following equilibrium constants are based on measurements by R.A. Cox and C.A. Hayman (Nature 332, 796 (1988)) on the reaction 2ClO (g) → (ClO)2 (g). T/K 233 248 258 268 273 280 K 4.13 × 108 5.00 × 107 1.45 × 107 5.37 × 106 3.20 × 106 9.62 × 105 T/K 288 295 303 K 4.28 × 105 1.67 × 105 7.02 × 104 (a) Derive the values of ∆rH7 and ∆rS7 for this reaction. (b) Compute the standard enthalpy of formation and the standard molar entropy of (ClO)2 given ∆fH7 (ClO) = +101.8 kJ mol−1 and S7 m(ClO) = 226.6 J K−1 mol−1 (CRC Handbook 2004). 7.35‡ Nitric acid hydrates have received much attention as possible catalysts for heterogeneous reactions that bring about the Antarctic ozone hole. Worsnop et al. investigated the thermodynamic stability of these hydrates under conditions typical of the polar winter stratosphere (D.R. Worsnop, L.E. Fox, M.S. Zahniser, and S.C. Wofsy, Science 259, 71 (1993)). Standard reaction Gibbs energies can be computed for the following reactions at 190 K from their data: (i) H2O (g)→ H2O (s) ∆rG7 = −23.6 kJ mol−1 (ii) H2O (g) + HNO3 (g) → HNO3·H2O (s) ∆rG7 = −57.2 kJ mol−1 (iii) 2 H2O (g) + HNO3 (g)→ HNO3·2H2O (s) ∆rG7 = −85.6 kJ mol−1 (iv) 3 H2O (g) + HNO3 (g) →HNO3·3H2O (s) ∆rG7 = −112.8 kJ mol−1 Which solid is thermodynamically most stable at 190 K if pH2O = 1.3×10−7 bar and pHNO3 = 4.1×10−10 bar? Hint. Try computing ∆rG for each reaction under the prevailing conditions; if more than one solid forms spontaneously, examine ∆rG for the conversion of one solid to another. 7.36‡ Suppose that an iron catalyst at a particular manufacturing plant produces ammonia in the most cost–effective manner at 450°C when the pressure is such that ∆rG for the reaction 1 –2 N2(g) + 3 –2 H2(g) → NH3(g) is equal to −500 J mol−1 . (a) What pressure is needed? (b) Now suppose that a new catalyst is developed that is most cost-effective at 400°C when the pressure gives the same value of ∆rG. What pressure is needed when the new catalyst is used? What are the advantages of the new catalyst? Assume that (i) all gases are perfect gases or that (ii) all gases are van der Waals gases. Isotherms of ∆rG(T, p) in the pressure range 100 atm ≤ p ≤ 400 atm are needed to derive the answer. (c) Do the isotherms you plotted confirm Le Chatelier’s principle concerning the response of equilibrium changes in temperature and pressure? This page intentionally left blank PART 2 Structure In Part 1 we examined the properties of bulk matter from the viewpoint of thermodynamics. In Part 2 we examine the structures and properties of individual atoms and molecules from the viewpoint of quantum mechanics. The two viewpoints merge in Chapters 16 and 17. 8 Quantum theory: introduction and principles 9 Quantum theory: techniques and applications 10 Atomic structure and atomic spectra 11 Molecular structure 12 Molecular symmetry 13 Molecular spectroscopy 1: rotational and vibrational spectra 14 Molecular spectroscopy 2: electronic transitions 15 Molecular spectroscopy 3: magnetic resonance 16 Statistical thermodynamics 1: the concepts 17 Statistical thermodynamics 2: applications 18 Molecular interactions 19 Materials 1: macromolecules and aggregates 20 Materials 2: the solid state This page intentionally left blank Quantum theory: introduction and principles This chapter introduces some of the basic principles of quantum mechanics. First, it reviews the experimental results that overthrew the concepts of classical physics. These experiments led to the conclusion that particles may not have an arbitrary energy and that the classical concepts of ‘particle’ and ‘wave’ blend together. The overthrow of classical mechanics inspired the formulation of a new set of concepts and led to the formulation of quantum mechanics. In quantum mechanics, all the properties of a system are expressed in terms of a wavefunction that is obtained by solving the Schrödinger equation. We see how to interpret wavefunctions. Finally, we introduce some of the techniques of quantum mechanics in terms of operators, and see that they lead to the uncertainty principle, one of the most profound departures from classical mechanics. It was once thought that the motion of atoms and subatomic particles could be expressed using classical mechanics, the laws of motion introduced in the seventeenth century by Isaac Newton, for these laws were very successful at explaining the motion of everyday objects and planets. However, towards the end of the nineteenth century, experimental evidence accumulated showing that classical mechanics failed when it was applied to particles as small as electrons, and it took until the 1920s to discover the appropriate concepts and equations for describing them. We describe the concepts of this new mechanics, which is called quantum mechanics, in this chapter, and apply them throughout the remainder of the text. The origins of quantum mechanics The basic principles of classical mechanics are reviewed in Appendix 2. In brief, they show that classical physics (1) predicts a precise trajectory for particles, with precisely specified locations and momenta at each instant, and (2) allows the translational, rotational, and vibrational modes of motion to be excited to any energy simply by controlling the forces that are applied. These conclusions agree with everyday experience. Everyday experience, however, does not extend to individual atoms, and careful experiments of the type described below have shown that classical mechanics fails when applied to the transfers of very small energies and to objects of very small mass. We shall also investigate the properties of light. In classical physics, light is described as electromagnetic radiation, which is understood in terms of the electromagnetic field, an oscillating electric and magnetic disturbance that spreads as a harmonic wave through empty space, the vacuum. Such waves are generated by the acceleration of electric charge, as in the oscillating motion of electrons in the antenna of a radio transmitter. The wave travels at a constant speed called the speed of light, c, which 8 The origins of quantum mechanics 8.1 The failures of classical physics 8.2 Wave–particle duality I8.1 Impact on biology: Electron microscopy The dynamics of microscopic systems 8.3 The Schrödinger equation 8.4 The Born interpretation of the wavefunction Quantum mechanical principles 8.5 The information in a wavefunction 8.6 The uncertainty principle 8.7 The postulates of quantum mechanics Checklist of key ideas Further reading Discussion questions Exercises Problems 244 8 QUANTUM THEORY: INTRODUCTION AND PRINCIPLES is about 3 × 108 m s−1 . As its name suggests, an electromagnetic field has two components, an electric field that acts on charged particles (whether stationary or moving) and a magnetic field that acts only on moving charged particles. The electromagnetic field is characterized by a wavelength, λ (lambda), the distance between the neighbouring peaks of the wave, and its frequency, ν (nu), the number of times per second at which its displacement at a fixed point returns to its original value (Fig. 8.1).The frequency is measured in hertz, where 1 Hz = 1 s−1 . The wavelength and frequency of an electromagnetic wave are related by λν = c (8.1) Therefore, the shorter the wavelength, the higher the frequency. The characteristics of the wave are also reported by giving the wavenumber, # (nu tilde), of the radiation, where # = = [8.2] Wavenumbers are normally reported in reciprocal centimetres (cm−1 ). Figure 8.2 summarizes the electromagnetic spectrum, the description and classification of the electromagnetic field according to its frequency and wavelength. White light is a mixture of electromagnetic radiation with wavelengths ranging from about 380 nm to about 700 nm (1 nm = 10−9 m). Our eyes perceive different wavelengths of radiation in this range as different colours, so it can be said that white light is a mixture of light of all different colours. The wave model falls short of describing all the properties of radiation. So, just as our view of particles (and in particular small particles) needs to be adjusted, a new view of light also has to be developed. 8.1 The failures of classical physics In this section we review some of the experimental evidence that showed that several concepts of classical mechanics are untenable. In particular, we shall see that observations of the radiation emitted by hot bodies, heat capacities, and the spectra of atoms and molecules indicate that systems can take up energy only in discrete amounts. (a) Black-body radiation A hot object emits electromagnetic radiation. At high temperatures, an appreciable proportion of the radiation is in the visible region of the spectrum, and a higher 1 λ ν c Comment 8.1 Harmonic waves are waves with displacements that can be expressed as sine or cosine functions. The physics of waves is reviewed in Appendix 3. Wavelength, (a) (b) l Fig. 8.1 The wavelength, λ, of a wave is the peak-to-peak distance. (b) The wave is shown travelling to the right at a speed c. At a given location, the instantaneous amplitude of the wave changes through a complete cycle (the four dots show half a cycle). The frequency, ν, is the number of cycles per second that occur at a given point. 10–14 10 –13 10 –12 10 –11 10 –10 10–9 10 –8 10 –7 10–6 10–5 10 –4 10 –3 10 –2 10 –1 1 1pm 1nm 1mm 1mm 1cm 1dm 1m Radio Micro- wave Far infrared Near infrared Ultraviolet Vacuum ultraviolet X-ray g-ray Cosmic rays Wavelength/m Molecular rotation Molecular vibration Electronic excitation Core-electron excitation Nuclear excitation Visible Red Violet Green 700nm 420nm Fig. 8.2 The electromagnetic spectrum and the classification of the spectral regions. 8.1 THE FAILURES OF CLASSICAL PHYSICS 245 proportion of short-wavelength blue light is generated as the temperature is raised. This behaviour is seen when a heated iron bar glowing red hot becomes white hot when heated further. The dependence is illustrated in Fig. 8.3, which shows how the energy output varies with wavelength at several temperatures. The curves are those of an ideal emitter called a black body, which is an object capable of emitting and absorbing all frequencies of radiation uniformly. A good approximation to a black body is a pinhole in an empty container maintained at a constant temperature, because any radiation leaking out of the hole has been absorbed and re-emitted inside so many times that it has come to thermal equilibrium with the walls (Fig. 8.4). The explanation of black-body radiation was a major challenge for nineteenthcentury scientists, and in due course it was found to be beyond the capabilities of classical physics. The physicist Lord Rayleigh studied it theoretically from a classical viewpoint, and thought of the electromagnetic field as a collection of oscillators of all possible frequencies. He regarded the presence of radiation of frequency ν (and therefore of wavelength λ = c/ν) as signifying that the electromagnetic oscillator of that frequency had been excited (Fig. 8.5). Rayleigh used the equipartition principle (Section 2.2) to calculate the average energy of each oscillator as kT. Then, with minor help from James Jeans, he arrived at the Rayleigh–Jeans law (see Further reading for its justification): dE = ρdλ ρ = (8.3) where ρ (rho), the density of states, is the proportionality constant between dλ and the energy density, dE, in the range of wavelengths between λ and λ + dλ, k is Boltzmann’s constant (k = 1.381 × 10−23 J K−1 ). The units of ρ are typically joules per metre4 (J m−4 ), to give an energy density dE in joules per cubic metre (J m−3 ) when multiplied by a wavelength range dλ in metres. A high density of states at the wavelength λ simply means that there is a lot of energy associated with wavelengths lying between λ and λ + dλ. The total energy density (in joules per cubic metre) in a region is obtained by integrating eqn 8.3 over all wavelengths between zero and infinity, and the total energy (in joules) within the region is obtained by multiplying that total energy density by the volume of the region. 8πkT λ4 Wavelength, Energydistribution, Increasing temperature Maximum of r r l Fig. 8.3 The energy distribution in a blackbody cavity at several temperatures. Note how the energy density increases in the region of shorter wavelengths as the temperature is raised, and how the peak shifts to shorter wavelengths. The total energy density (the area under the curve) increases as the temperature is increased (as T4 ). Detected radiation Pinhole Container at a temperature T Fig. 8.4 An experimental representation of a black-body is a pinhole in an otherwise closed container. The radiation is reflected many times within the container and comes to thermal equilibrium with the walls at a temperature T. Radiation leaking out through the pinhole is characteristic of the radiation within the container. (a) (b) Fig. 8.5 The electromagnetic vacuum can be regarded as able to support oscillations of the electromagnetic field. When a high frequency, short wavelength oscillator (a) is excited, that frequency of radiation is present. The presence of low frequency, long wavelength radiation (b) signifies that an oscillator of the corresponding frequency has been excited. 246 8 QUANTUM THEORY: INTRODUCTION AND PRINCIPLES Unfortunately (for Rayleigh, Jeans, and classical physics), although the Rayleigh– Jeans law is quite successful at long wavelengths (low frequencies), it fails badly at short wavelengths (high frequencies). Thus, as λ decreases, ρ increases without going through a maximum (Fig. 8.6). The equation therefore predicts that oscillators of very short wavelength (corresponding to ultraviolet radiation, X-rays, and even γ-rays) are strongly excited even at room temperature. This absurd result, which implies that a large amount of energy is radiated in the high-frequency region of the electromagnetic spectrum, is called the ultraviolet catastrophe. According to classical physics, even cool objects should radiate in the visible and ultraviolet regions, so objects should glow in the dark; there should in fact be no darkness. (b) The Planck distribution The German physicist Max Planck studied black-body radiation from the viewpoint of thermodynamics. In 1900 he found that he could account for the experimental observations by proposing that the energy of each electromagnetic oscillator is limited to discrete values and cannot be varied arbitrarily. This proposal is quite contrary to the viewpoint of classical physics (on which the equipartition principle used by Rayleigh is based), in which all possible energies are allowed. The limitation of energies to discrete values is called the quantization of energy. In particular, Planck found that he could account for the observed distribution of energy if he supposed that the permitted energies of an electromagnetic oscillator of frequency ν are integer multiples of hν: E = nhν n = 0, 1, 2, . . . (8.4) where h is a fundamental constant now known as Planck’s constant. On the basis of this assumption, Planck was able to derive the Planck distribution: dE = ρdλ ρ = (8.5) (For references to the derivation of this expression, see Further reading.) This expression fits the experimental curve very well at all wavelengths (Fig. 8.7), and the value of h, which is an undetermined parameter in the theory, may be obtained by varying its value until a best fit is obtained. The currently accepted value for h is 6.626 × 10−34 J s. The Planck distribution resembles the Rayleigh–Jeans law (eqn 8.3) apart from the all-important exponential factor in the denominator. For short wavelengths, hc/λkT >> 1 and ehc/λkT → ∞ faster than λ5 → 0; therefore ρ → 0 as λ → 0 or ν → ∞. Hence, the energy density approaches zero at high frequencies, in agreement with observation. For long wavelengths, hc/λkT << 1, and the denominator in the Planck distribution can be replaced by ehc/λkT − 1 = 1 + + · · · − 1 ≈ When this approximation is substituted into eqn 8.5, we find that the Planck distribution reduces to the Rayleigh–Jeans law. It is quite easy to see why Planck’s approach was successful while Rayleigh’s was not. The thermal motion of the atoms in the walls of the black body excites the oscillators of the electromagnetic field. According to classical mechanics, all the oscillators of the field share equally in the energy supplied by the walls, so even the highest frequencies are excited. The excitation of very high frequency oscillators results in the ultraviolet catastrophe. According to Planck’s hypothesis, however, oscillators are excited only if hc λkT D F hc λkT A C 8πhc λ5 (ehc/λkT − 1) 25 20 15 10 5 0 0 0.5 1.0 1.5 2.0 /{8()/()}pkThc54 kT hc/ r l Fig. 8.7 The Planck distribution (eqn 8.5) accounts very well for the experimentally determined distribution of black-body radiation. Planck’s quantization hypothesis essentially quenches the contributions of high frequency, short wavelength oscillators. The distribution coincides with the Rayleigh–Jeans distribution at long wavelengths. Exploration Plot the Planck distribution at several temperatures and confirm that eqn 8.5 predicts the behaviour summarized by Fig. 8.2. Rayleigh– Jeans law Experimental Energydensity, Wavelength, r l Fig. 8.6 The Rayleigh–Jeans law (eqn 8.3) predicts an infinite energy density at short wavelengths. This approach to infinity is called the ultraviolet catastrophe. 8.1 THE FAILURES OF CLASSICAL PHYSICS 247 they can acquire an energy of at least hν. This energy is too large for the walls to supply in the case of the very high frequency oscillators, so the latter remain unexcited. The effect of quantization is to reduce the contribution from the high frequency oscillators, for they cannot be significantly excited with the energy available. (c) Heat capacities In the early nineteenth century, the French scientists Pierre-Louis Dulong and AlexisThérèse Petit determined the heat capacities of a number of monatomic solids. On the basis of some somewhat slender experimental evidence, they proposed that the molar heat capacities of all monatomic solids are the same and (in modern units) close to 25 J K−1 mol−1 . Dulong and Petit’s law is easy to justify in terms of classical physics. If classical physics were valid, the equipartition principle could be used to calculate the heat capacity of a solid. According to this principle, the mean energy of an atom as it oscillates about its mean position in a solid is kT for each direction of displacement. As each atom can oscillate in three dimensions, the average energy of each atom is 3kT; for N atoms the total energy is 3NkT. The contribution of this motion to the molar internal energy is therefore Um = 3NAkT = 3RT because NAk = R, the gas constant. The molar constant volume heat capacity (see Comment 8.3) is then predicted to be CV,m = V = 3R (8.6) This result, with 3R = 24.9 J K−1 mol−1 , is in striking accord with Dulong and Petit’s value. Unfortunately (this time, for Dulong and Petit), significant deviations from their law were observed when advances in refrigeration techniques made it possible to measure heat capacities at low temperatures. It was found that the molar heat capacities of all monatomic solids are lower than 3R at low temperatures, and that the values approach zero as T → 0. To account for these observations, Einstein (in 1905) assumed that each atom oscillated about its equilibrium position with a single frequency ν. He then invoked Planck’s hypothesis to assert that the energy of oscillation is confined to discrete values, and specifically to nhν, where n is an integer. Einstein first calculated the contribution of the oscillations of the atoms to the total molar energy of the metal (by a method described in Section 16.4) and obtained Um = in place of the classical expression 3RT. Then he found the molar heat capacity by differentiating Um with respect to T. The resulting expression is now known as the Einstein formula: CV,m = 3Rf f = 2 2 (8.7) The Einstein temperature, θE = hν/k, is a way of expressing the frequency of oscillation of the atoms as a temperature: a high frequency corresponds to a high Einstein temperature. D F eθE/2T eθE/T − 1 A C D F θE T A C 3NAhν ehν/kT − 1 D F ∂Um ∂T A C Comment 8.2 The series expansion of an exponential function is ex = 1 + x + 1–2 x2 + · · · . If x << 1, a good approximation is ex ≈ 1 + x. For example, e0.01 = 1.010 050 . . . ≈ 1 + 0.01. Comment 8.3 The internal energy, U, a concept from thermodynamics (Chapter 2), can be regarded as the total energy of the particles making up a sample of matter. The constant-volume heat capacity is defined as CV = (∂U/∂T)V. A small heat capacity indicates that a large rise in temperature results from a given transfer of energy. 248 8 QUANTUM THEORY: INTRODUCTION AND PRINCIPLES 3 2 1 0 0 0.5 1 1.5 2 C/RV,m T/ Eq Fig. 8.8 Experimental low-temperature molar heat capacities and the temperature dependence predicted on the basis of Einstein’s theory. His equation (eqn 8.7) accounts for the dependence fairly well, but is everywhere too low. Exploration Using eqn 8.7, plot CV,m against T for several values of the Einstein temperature θE. At low temperature, does an increase in θE result in an increase or decrease of CV,m? Estimate the temperature at which the value of CV,m reaches the classical value given by eqn 8.6. At high temperatures (when T >> θE) the exponentials in f can be expanded as 1 + θE/T + · · · and higher terms ignored (see Comment 8.2). The result is f = 2 2 ≈ 1 (8.8a) Consequently, the classical result (CV,m = 3R) is obtained at high temperatures. At low temperatures, when T << θE, f ≈ 2 2 = 2 e−θE/T (8.8b) The strongly decaying exponential function goes to zero more rapidly than 1/T goes to infinity; so f → 0 as T → 0, and the heat capacity therefore approaches zero too. We see that Einstein’s formula accounts for the decrease of heat capacity at low temperatures. The physical reason for this success is that at low temperatures only a few oscillators possess enough energy to oscillate significantly. At higher temperatures, there is enough energy available for all the oscillators to become active: all 3N oscillators contribute, and the heat capacity approaches its classical value. Figure 8.8 shows the temperature dependence of the heat capacity predicted by the Einstein formula. The general shape of the curve is satisfactory, but the numerical agreement is in fact quite poor. The poor fit arises from Einstein’s assumption that all the atoms oscillate with the same frequency, whereas in fact they oscillate over a range of frequencies from zero up to a maximum value, νD. This complication is taken into account by averaging over all the frequencies present, the final result being the Debye formula: CV,m = 3Rf f = 3 3 Ύ0 θD/T dx (8.9) where θD = hνD/k is the Debye temperature (for a derivation, see Further reading). The integral in eqn 8.9 has to be evaluated numerically, but that is simple with mathematical software. The details of this modification, which, as Fig. 8.9 shows, gives improved agreement with experiment, need not distract us at this stage from the main conclusion, which is that quantization must be introduced in order to explain the thermal properties of solids. Illustration 8.1 Assessing the heat capacity The Debye temperature for lead is 105 K, corresponding to a vibrational frequency of 2.2 × 1012 Hz, whereas that for diamond and its much lighter, more rigidly bonded atoms, is 2230 K, corresponding to 4.6 × 1013 Hz. As we see from Fig. 8.9, f ≈ 1 for T > θD and the heat capacity is almost classical. For lead at 25°C, corresponding to T/θD = 2.8, f = 0.99 and the heat capacity has almost its classical value. For diamond at the same temperature, T/θD = 0.13, corresponding to f = 0.15, and the heat capacity is only 15 per cent of its classical value. (d) Atomic and molecular spectra The most compelling evidence for the quantization of energy comes from spectroscopy, the detection and analysis of the electromagnetic radiation absorbed, emitted, or scattered by a substance. The record of the intensity of light intensity transmitted x4 ex (ex − 1)2 D F T θD A C D F θE T A C D F eθE/2T eθE/T A C D F θE T A C 5 6 7 1 + θE/2T + · · · (1 + θE/T + · · · ) − 1 1 2 3 D F θE T A C 8.2 WAVE–PARTICLE DUALITY 249 orscatteredbyamoleculeasafunctionoffrequency(ν),wavelength(λ),orwavenumber (# = ν/c) is called its spectrum (from the Latin word for appearance). A typical atomic spectrum is shown in Fig. 8.10, and a typical molecular spectrum is shown in Fig. 8.11. The obvious feature of both is that radiation is emitted or absorbed at a series of discrete frequencies. This observation can be understood if the energy of the atoms or molecules is also confined to discrete values, for then energy can be discarded or absorbed only in discrete amounts (Fig. 8.12). Then, if the energy of an atom decreases by ∆E, the energy is carried away as radiation of frequency ν, and an emission ‘line’, a sharply defined peak, appears in the spectrum. We say that a molecule undergoes a spectroscopic transition, a change of state, when the Bohr frequency condition ∆E = hν (8.10) is fulfilled. We develop the principles and applications of atomic spectroscopy in Chapter 10 and of molecular spectroscopy in Chapters 13–15. 8.2 Wave–particle duality At this stage we have established that the energies of the electromagnetic field and of oscillating atoms are quantized. In this section we shall see the experimental evidence that led to the revision of two other basic concepts concerning natural phenomena. One experiment shows that electromagnetic radiation—which classical physics treats as wave-like—actually also displays the characteristics of particles. Another experiment shows that electrons—which classical physics treats as particles—also display the characteristics of waves. 3 2 1 0 Einstein 0 0.5 1 1.5 2 C/RV,m Debye T T/ or /E Dq q Fig. 8.9 Debye’s modification of Einstein’s calculation (eqn 8.9) gives very good agreement with experiment. For copper, T/θD = 2 corresponds to about 170 K, so the detection of deviations from Dulong and Petit’s law had to await advances in low-temperature physics. Exploration Starting with the Debye formula (eqn 8.9), plot dCV,m/dT, the temperature coefficient of CV,m, against T for θD = 400 K. At what temperature is CV,m most sensitive to temperature? 415 420 Emissionintensity Wavelength, /nml Fig. 8.10 A region of the spectrum of radiation emitted by excited iron atoms consists of radiation at a series of discrete wavelengths (or frequencies). Energy E1 E2 E3 h E E= 2 1h E E= 3 1h E E= 3 2-n n n Fig. 8.12 Spectroscopic transitions, such as those shown above, can be accounted for if we assume that a molecule emits a photon as it changes between discrete energy levels. Note that high-frequency radiation is emitted when the energy change is large. 200 240 280 320 /nm Absorptionintensity l Fig. 8.11 When a molecule changes its state, it does so by absorbing radiation at definite frequencies. This spectrum is part of that due to the electronic, vibrational, and rotational excitation of sulfur dioxide (SO2) molecules. This observation suggests that molecules can possess only discrete energies, not an arbitrary energy. 250 8 QUANTUM THEORY: INTRODUCTION AND PRINCIPLES (a) The particle character of electromagnetic radiation The observation that electromagnetic radiation of frequency ν can possess only the energies 0, hν, 2hν, . . . suggests that it can be thought of as consisting of 0, 1, 2, . . . particles, each particle having an energy hν. Then, if one of these particles is present, the energy is hν, if two are present the energy is 2hν, and so on. These particles of electromagnetic radiation are now called photons. The observation of discrete spectra from atoms and molecules can be pictured as the atom or molecule generating a photon of energy hν when it discards an energy of magnitude ∆E, with ∆E = hν. Example 8.1 Calculating the number of photons Calculate the number of photons emitted by a 100 W yellow lamp in 1.0 s. Take the wavelength of yellow light as 560 nm and assume 100 per cent efficiency. Method Each photon has an energy hν, so the total number of photons needed to produce an energy E is E/hν. To use this equation, we need to know the frequency of the radiation (from ν = c/λ) and the total energy emitted by the lamp. The latter is given by the product of the power (P, in watts) and the time interval for which the lamp is turned on (E = P∆t). Answer The number of photons is N = = = Substitution of the data gives N = = 2.8 × 1020 Note that it would take nearly 40 min to produce 1 mol of these photons. A note on good practice To avoid rounding and other numerical errors, it is best to carry out algebraic manipulations first, and to substitute numerical values into a single, final formula. Moreover, an analytical result may be used for other data without having to repeat the entire calculation. Self-test 8.1 How many photons does a monochromatic (single frequency) infrared rangefinder of power 1 mW and wavelength 1000 nm emit in 0.1 s? [5 × 1014 ] Further evidence for the particle-like character of radiation comes from the measurement of the energies of electrons produced in the photoelectric effect. This effect is the ejection of electrons from metals when they are exposed to ultraviolet radiation. The experimental characteristics of the photoelectric effect are as follows: 1 No electrons are ejected, regardless of the intensity of the radiation, unless its frequency exceeds a threshold value characteristic of the metal. 2 The kinetic energy of the ejected electrons increases linearly with the frequency of the incident radiation but is independent of the intensity of the radiation. 3 Even at low light intensities, electrons are ejected immediately if the frequency is above the threshold. (5.60 × 10−7 m) × (100 J s−1 ) × (1.0 s) (6.626 × 10−34 J s) × (2.998 × 108 m s−1 ) λP∆t hc P∆t h(c/λ) E hν 8.2 WAVE–PARTICLE DUALITY 251 Figure 8.13 illustrates the first and second characteristics. These observations strongly suggest that the photoelectric effect depends on the ejection of an electron when it is involved in a collision with a particle-like projectile that carries enough energy to eject the electron from the metal. If we suppose that the projectile is a photon of energy hν, where ν is the frequency of the radiation, then the conservation of energy requires that the kinetic energy of the ejected electron should obey 1 –2mev2 = hν − Φ (8.11) In this expression Φ is a characteristic of the metal called its workfunction, the energy required to remove an electron from the metal to infinity (Fig. 8.14), the analogue of the ionization energy of an individual atom or molecule. Photoejection cannot occur if hν < Φ because the photon brings insufficient energy: this conclusion accounts for observation (1). Equation 8.11 predicts that the kinetic energy of an ejected electron should increase linearly with frequency, in agreement with observation (2). When a photon collides with an electron, it gives up all its energy, so we should expect electrons to appear as soon as the collisions begin, provided the photons have sufficient energy; Kineticenergyofphotoelectron,EK Frequency of incident radiation, RubidiumPotassium Sodium Increasing work function 2.30eV(1.8610cm,539nm)´41 2.25eV(1.8110cm,551nm)´41 2.09eV(1.6910cm,593nm)´41 n - - Fig. 8.13 In the photoelectric effect, it is found that no electrons are ejected when the incident radiation has a frequency below a value characteristic of the metal and, above that value, the kinetic energy of the photoelectrons varies linearly with the frequency of the incident radiation. Exploration Calculate the value of Planck’s constant given that the following kinetic energies were observed for photoejected electrons irradiated by radiation of the wavelengths noted. λi/nm 320 330 345 360 385 EK/eV 1.17 1.05 0.885 0.735 0.511 Energy needed to remove electron from metal Kinetic energy of ejected electron m ve 2 F (b)(a) h F 2 1 n hn Fig. 8.14 The photoelectric effect can be explained if it is supposed that the incident radiation is composed of photons that have energy proportional to the frequency of the radiation. (a) The energy of the photon is insufficient to drive an electron out of the metal. (b) The energy of the photon is more than enough to eject an electron, and the excess energy is carried away as the kinetic energy of the photoelectron (the ejected electron). 252 8 QUANTUM THEORY: INTRODUCTION AND PRINCIPLES Comment 8.4 A characteristic property of waves is that they interfere with one another, giving a greater displacement where peaks or troughs coincide, leading to constructive interference, and a smaller displacement where peaks coincide with troughs, leading to destructive interference (see the illustration: (a) constructive, (b) destructive). Electron beam Nickel crystal Diffracted electrons Fig. 8.15 The Davisson–Germer experiment. The scattering of an electron beam from a nickel crystal shows a variation of intensity characteristic of a diffraction experiment in which waves interfere constructively and destructively in different directions. (a) (b) this conclusion agrees with observation (3). A practical application of eqn 8.11 is that it provides a technique for the determination of Planck’s constant, for the slopes of the lines in Fig. 8.13 are all equal to h. (b) The wave character of particles Although contrary to the long-established wave theory of light, the view that light consists of particles had been held before, but discarded. No significant scientist, however, had taken the view that matter is wave-like. Nevertheless, experiments carried out in 1925 forced people to consider that possibility. The crucial experiment was performed by the American physicists Clinton Davisson and Lester Germer, who observed the diffraction of electrons by a crystal (Fig. 8.15). Diffraction is the interference caused by an object in the path of waves. Depending on whether the interference is constructive or destructive, the result is a region of enhanced or diminished intensity of the wave. Davisson and Germer’s success was a lucky accident, because a chance rise of temperature caused their polycrystalline sample to anneal, and the ordered planes of atoms then acted as a diffraction grating. At almost the same time, G.P. Thomson, working in Scotland, showed that a beam of electrons was diffracted when passed through a thin gold foil. Electron diffraction is the basis for special techniques in microscopy used by biologists and materials scientists (Impact I8.1 and Section 20.4). The Davisson–Germer experiment, which has since been repeated with other particles (including α particles and molecular hydrogen), shows clearly that particles have wave-like properties, and the diffraction of neutrons is a well-established technique for investigating the structures and dynamics of condensed phases (see Chapter 20). We have also seen that waves of electromagnetic radiation have particle-like properties. Thus we are brought to the heart of modern physics. When examined on an atomic scale, the classical concepts of particle and wave melt together, particles taking on the characteristics of waves, and waves the characteristics of particles. Some progress towards coordinating these properties had already been made by the French physicist Louis de Broglie when, in 1924, he suggested that any particle, not only photons, travelling with a linear momentum p should have (in some sense) a wavelength given by the de Broglie relation: λ = (8.12) That is, a particle with a high linear momentum has a short wavelength (Fig. 8.16). Macroscopic bodies have such high momenta (because their mass is so great), even when they are moving slowly, that their wavelengths are undetectably small, and the wave-like properties cannot be observed. Example 8.2 Estimating the de Broglie wavelength Estimate the wavelength of electrons that have been accelerated from rest through a potential difference of 40 kV. Method To use the de Broglie relation, we need to know the linear momentum, p, of the electrons. To calculate the linear momentum, we note that the energy acquired by an electron accelerated through a potential difference V is eV, where e is the magnitude of its charge. At the end of the period of acceleration, all the acquired energy is in the form of kinetic energy, EK = p2 /2me, so we can determine p by setting p2 /2me equal to eV. As before, carry through the calculation algebraically before substituting the data. h p 8.2 WAVE–PARTICLE DUALITY 253 Short wavelength, high momentum Long wavelength, low momentum Fig. 8.16 An illustration of the de Broglie relation between momentum and wavelength. The wave is associated with a particle (shortly this wave will be seen to be the wavefunction of the particle). A particle with high momentum has a wavefunction with a short wavelength, and vice versa. Answer The expression p2 /2me = eV solves to p = (2meeV)1/2 ; then, from the de Broglie relation λ = h/p, λ = Substitution of the data and the fundamental constants (from inside the front cover) gives λ = = 6.1 × 10−12 m where we have used 1 V C = 1 J and 1 J = 1 kg m2 s−2 . The wavelength of 6.1 pm is shorter than typical bond lengths in molecules (about 100 pm). Electrons accelerated in this way are used in the technique of electron diffraction for the determination of molecular structure (see Section 20.4). Self-test 8.2 Calculate (a) the wavelength of a neutron with a translational kinetic energy equal to kT at 300 K, (b) a tennis ball of mass 57 g travelling at 80 km/h. [(a) 178 pm, (b) 5.2 × 10−34 m] We now have to conclude that, not only has electromagnetic radiation the character classically ascribed to particles, but electrons (and all other particles) have the characteristics classically ascribed to waves. This joint particle and wave character of matter and radiation is called wave–particle duality. Duality strikes at the heart of classical physics, where particles and waves are treated as entirely distinct entities. We have also seen that the energies of electromagnetic radiation and of matter cannot be varied continuously, and that for small objects the discreteness of energy is highly significant. In classical mechanics, in contrast, energies could be varied continuously. Such total failure of classical physics for small objects implied that its basic concepts were false. A new mechanics had to be devised to take its place. IMPACT ON BIOLOGY I8.1 Electron microscopy The basic approach of illuminating a small area of a sample and collecting light with a microscope has been used for many years to image small specimens. However, the resolution of a microscope, the minimum distance between two objects that leads to two distinct images, is on the order of the wavelength of light used as a probe (see Impact I13.1). Therefore, conventional microscopes employing visible light have resolutions in the micrometre range and are blind to features on a scale of nanometres. There is great interest in the development of new experimental probes of very small specimens that cannot be studied by traditional light microscopy. For example, our understanding of biochemical processes, such as enzymatic catalysis, protein folding, and the insertion of DNA into the cell’s nucleus, will be enhanced if it becomes possible to image individual biopolymers—with dimensions much smaller than visible wavelengths—at work. One technique that is often used to image nanometre-sized objects is electron microscopy, in which a beam of electrons with a well defined de Broglie wavelength replaces the lamp found in traditional light microscopes. Instead of glass or quartz lenses, magnetic fields are used to focus the beam. In transmission electron microscopy (TEM), the electron beam passes through the specimen and the 6.626 × 10−34 J s {2 × (9.109 × 10−31 kg) × (1.609 × 10−19 C) × (4.0 × 104 V)}1/2 h (2meeV)1/2 254 8 QUANTUM THEORY: INTRODUCTION AND PRINCIPLES image is collected on a screen. In scanning electron microscopy (SEM), electrons scattered back from a small irradiated area of the sample are detected and the electrical signal is sent to a video screen. An image of the surface is then obtained by scanning the electron beam across the sample. As in traditional light microscopy, the wavelength of and the ability to focus the incident beam—in this case a beam of electrons—govern the resolution. Electron wavelengths in typical electron microscopes can be as short as 10 pm, but it is not possible to focus electrons well with magnetic lenses so, in the end, typical resolutions of TEM and SEM instruments are about 2 nm and 50 nm, respectively. It follows that electron microscopes cannot resolve individual atoms (which have diameters of about 0.2 nm). Furthermore, only certain samples can be observed under certain conditions. The measurements must be conducted under high vacuum. For TEM observations, the samples must be very thin cross-sections of a specimen and SEM observations must be made on dry samples. A consequence of these requirements is that neither technique can be used to study living cells. In spite of these limitations, electron microscopy is very useful in studies of the internal structure of cells (Fig. 8.17). The dynamics of microscopic systems Quantum mechanics acknowledges the wave–particle duality of matter by supposing that, rather than travelling along a definite path, a particle is distributed through space like a wave. This remark may seem mysterious: it will be interpreted more fully shortly. The mathematical representation of the wave that in quantum mechanics replaces the classical concept of trajectory is called a wavefunction, ψ (psi). 8.3 The Schrödinger equation In 1926, the Austrian physicist Erwin Schrödinger proposed an equation for finding the wavefunction of any system. The time-independent Schrödinger equation for a particle of mass m moving in one dimension with energy E is − + V(x)ψ = Eψ (8.13) The factor V(x) is the potential energy of the particle at the point x; because the total energy E is the sum of potential and kinetic energies, the first term must be related (in a manner we explore later) to the kinetic energy of the particle; $ (which is read h-cross or h-bar) is a convenient modification of Planck’s constant: $ = = 1.054 57 × 10−34 J s (8.14) For a partial justification of the form of the Schrödinger equation, see the Justification below. The discussions later in the chapter will help to overcome the apparent arbitrariness of this complicated expression. For the present, treat the equation as a quantum-mechanical postulate. Various ways of expressing the Schrödinger equation, of incorporating the time-dependence of the wavefunction, and of extending it to more dimensions, are collected in Table 8.1. In Chapter 9 we shall solve the equation for a number of important cases; in this chapter we are mainly concerned with its significance, the interpretation of its solutions, and seeing how it implies that energy is quantized. h 2π d2 ψ dx2 $2 2m Fig. 8.17 A TEM image of a cross-section of a plant cell showing chloroplasts, organelles responsible for the reactions of photosynthesis (Chapter 23). Chloroplasts are typically 5 µm long. (Image supplied by Brian Bowes.) 8.3 THE SCHRÖDINGER EQUATION 255 Justification 8.1 Using the Schrödinger equation to develop the de Broglie relation Although the Schrödinger equation should be regarded as a postulate, like Newton’s equations of motion, it can be seen to be plausible by noting that it implies the de Broglie relation for a freely moving particle in a region with constant potential energy V. After making the substitution V(x) = V, we can rearrange eqn 8.13 into = − (E − V)ψ General strategies for solving differential equations of this and other types that occur frequently in physical chemistry are treated in Appendix 2. In the case at hand, we note that a solution is ψ = eikx k = 1/25 6 7 2m(E − V) $2 1 2 3 2m $2 d2 ψ dx2 Table 8.1 The Schrödinger equation For one-dimensional systems: − + V(x)ψ = Eψ Where V(x) is the potential energy of the particle and E is its total energy. For three-dimensional systems − ∇2 ψ + Vψ = Eψ where V may depend on position and ∇2 (‘del squared’) is ∇2 = + + In systems with spherical symmetry three equivalent forms are ∇2 = r + Λ2 = r2 + Λ2 = + + Λ2 where Λ2 = + sinθ In the general case the Schrodinger equation is written @ψ = Eψ where @ is the hamiltonian operator for the system: @ = − ∇2 + V For the evolution of a system with time, it is necessary to solve the time-dependent Schrödinger equation: @Ψ = i$ ∂Ψ ∂t $2 2m ∂ ∂θ ∂ ∂θ 1 sinθ ∂2 ∂φ2 1 sin2 θ 1 r2 ∂ ∂r 2 r ∂2 ∂r2 1 r2 ∂ ∂r ∂ ∂r 1 r2 1 r2 ∂2 ∂r2 1 r ∂2 ∂z2 ∂2 ∂y2 ∂2 ∂x2 $2 2m d2 ψ dx2 $2 2m 256 8 QUANTUM THEORY: INTRODUCTION AND PRINCIPLES Comment 8.6 To form the complex conjugate, ψ*, of a complex function, replace i wherever it occurs by −i. For instance, the complex conjugate of eikx is e−ikx . If the wavefunction is real, |ψ|2 = ψ2 . In quantum mechanics, a wavefunction that describes the spatial distribution of a particle (a ‘spatial wavefunction’) is complex if the particle it describes has a net motion. In the present case, we can use the relation eiθ = cos θ + i sin θ to write ψ = cos kx + i sin kx The real and imaginary parts of ψ are drawn in Fig. 8.18, and we see that the imaginary component Im(ψ) = sin kx is shifted in the direction of the particle’s motion. That is, both the real and imaginary parts of the wavefunction are ‘real’, in the sense of being present, and we express ψ as a complex function simply to help with the visualization of the motion of the particle the wavefunction desribes. Now we recognize that cos kx (or sin kx) is a wave of wavelength λ = 2π/k, as can be seen by comparing cos kx with the standard form of a harmonic wave, cos(2πx/λ). The quantity E − V is equal to the kinetic energy of the particle, EK, so k = (2mEK/$2 )1/2 , which implies that EK = k2 $2 /2m. Because EK = p2 /2m, it follows that p = k$ Therefore, the linear momentum is related to the wavelength of the wavefunction by p = × = which is the de Broglie relation. 8.4 The Born interpretation of the wavefunction A principal tenet of quantum mechanics is that the wavefunction contains all the dynamical information about the system it describes. Here we concentrate on the information it carries about the location of the particle. The interpretation of the wavefunction in terms of the location of the particle is based on a suggestion made by Max Born. He made use of an analogy with the wave theory of light, in which the square of the amplitude of an electromagnetic wave in a region is interpreted as its intensity and therefore (in quantum terms) as a measure of the probability of finding a photon present in the region. The Born interpretation of the wavefunction focuses on the square of the wavefunction (or the square modulus, |ψ|2 = ψ*ψ, if ψ is complex). It states that the value of |ψ|2 at a point is proportional to the probability of finding the particle in a region around that point. Specifically, for a one-dimensional system (Fig. 8.19): If the wavefunction of a particle has the value ψ at some point x, then the probability of finding the particle between x and x + dx is proportional to |ψ|2 dx. Thus, |ψ|2 is the probability density, and to obtain the probability it must be multiplied by the length of the infinitesimal region dx. The wavefunction ψ itself is called the probabilityamplitude. For a particle free to move in three dimensions (for example, an electron near a nucleus in an atom), the wavefunction depends on the point dr with coordinates x, y, and z, and the interpretation of ψ(r) is as follows (Fig. 8.20): If the wavefunction of a particle has the value ψ at some point r, then the probability of finding the particle in an infinitesimal volume dτ = dxdydz at that point is proportional to |ψ|2 dτ. The Born interpretation does away with any worry about the significance of a negative (and, in general, complex) value of ψ because |ψ|2 is real and never negative. There is no direct significance in the negative (or complex) value of a wavefunction: only the square modulus, a positive quantity, is directly physically significant, and both negative and positive regions of a wavefunction may correspond to a high h λ h 2π 2π λ Comment 8.5 Complex numbers and functions are discussed in Appendix 2. Complex numbers have the form z = x + iy, where i = (−1)1/2 and the real numbers x and y are the real and imaginary parts of z, denoted Re(z) and Im(z), respectively. Similarly, a complex function of the form f = g + ih, where g and h are functions of real arguments, has a real part Re(f) = g and an imaginary part Im(f ) = h. Im e = sin ikx kx Re e = cosikx kx Wavefunction,y Fig. 8.18 The real (purple) and imaginary (blue) parts of a free particle wavefunction corresponding to motion towards positive x (as shown by the arrow). dx x x xd+ Probability = | | d2 x | |2 y y Fig. 8.19 The wavefunction ψ is a probability amplitude in the sense that its square modulus (ψ*ψ or |ψ|2 ) is a probability density. The probability of finding a particle in the region dx located at x is proportional to |ψ|2 dx. We represent the probability density by the density of shading in the superimposed band. 8.4 THE BORN INTERPRETATION OF THE WAVEFUNCTION 257 z x y d r dx dy dz t Fig. 8.20 The Born interpretation of the wavefunction in three-dimensional space implies that the probability of finding the particle in the volume element dτ = dxdydz at some location r is proportional to the product of dτ and the value of |ψ|2 at that location. Fig. 8.21 The sign of a wavefunction has no direct physical significance: the positive and negative regions of this wavefunction both correspond to the same probability distribution (as given by the square modulus of ψ and depicted by the density of shading). probability of finding a particle in a region (Fig. 8.21). However, later we shall see that the presence of positive and negative regions of a wavefunction is of great indirect significance, because it gives rise to the possibility of constructive and destructive interference between different wavefunctions. Example 8.3 Interpreting a wavefunction We shall see in Chapter 12 that the wavefunction of an electron in the lowest energy state of a hydrogen atom is proportional to e−r/a0 , with a0 a constant and r the distance from the nucleus. (Notice that this wavefunction depends only on this distance, not the angular position relative to the nucleus.) Calculate the relative probabilities of finding the electron inside a region of volume 1.0 pm3 , which is small even on the scale of the atom, located at (a) the nucleus, (b) a distance a0 from the nucleus. Method The region of interest is so small on the scale of the atom that we can ignore the variation of ψ within it and write the probability, P, as proportional to the probability density (ψ2 ; note that ψ is real) evaluated at the point of interest multiplied by the volume of interest, δV. That is, P ∝ ψ2 δV, with ψ2 ∝ e−2r/a0 . Answer In each case δV = 1.0 pm3 . (a) At the nucleus, r = 0, so P ∝ e0 × (1.0 pm3 ) = (1.0) × (1.0 pm3 ) (b) At a distance r = a0 in an arbitrary direction, P ∝ e−2 × (1.0 pm3 ) = (0.14 ) × (1.0 pm3 ) Therefore, the ratio of probabilities is 1.0/0.14 = 7.1. Note that it is more probable (by a factor of 7) that the electron will be found at the nucleus than in a volume element of the same size located at a distance a0 from the nucleus. The negatively charged electron is attracted to the positively charged nucleus, and is likely to be found close to it. A note on good practice The square of a wavefunction is not a probability: it is a probability density, and (in three dimensions) has the dimensions of 1/length3 . It becomes a (unitless) probability when multiplied by a volume. In general, we have to take into account the variation of the amplitude of the wavefunction over the volume of interest, but here we are supposing that the volume is so small that the variation of ψ in the region can be ignored. Self-test 8.3 The wavefunction for the electron in its lowest energy state in the ion He+ is proportional to e−2r/a0 . Repeat the calculation for this ion. Any comment? [55; more compact wavefunction] (a) Normalization A mathematical feature of the Schrödinger equation is that, if ψ is a solution, then so is Nψ, where N is any constant. This feature is confirmed by noting that ψ occurs in every term in eqn 8.13, so any constant factor can be cancelled. This freedom to vary the wavefunction by a constant factor means that it is always possible to find a normalization constant, N, such that the proportionality of the Born interpretation becomes an equality. Probability density Wavefunction 258 8 QUANTUM THEORY: INTRODUCTION AND PRINCIPLES q f 02p 0 p Fig. 8.23 The surface of a sphere is covered by allowing θ to range from 0 to π, and then sweeping that arc around a complete circle by allowing φ to range from 0 to 2π. We find the normalization constant by noting that, for a normalized wavefunction Nψ, the probability that a particle is in the region dx is equal to (Nψ*)(Nψ)dx (we are taking N to be real). Furthermore, the sum over all space of these individual probabilities must be 1 (the probability of the particle being somewhere is 1). Expressed mathematically, the latter requirement is N2 Ύ ∞ −∞ ψ*ψdx = 1 (8.15) Almost all wavefunctions go to zero at sufficiently great distances so there is rarely any difficulty with the evaluation of this integral, and wavefunctions for which the integral in eqn 8.15 exists (in the sense of having a finite value) are said to be ‘squareintegrable’. It follows that N = Ύ ∞ −∞ ψ*ψdx 1/2 (8.16) Therefore, by evaluating the integral, we can find the value of N and hence ‘normalize’ the wavefunction. From now on, unless we state otherwise, we always use wavefunctions that have been normalized to 1; that is, from now on we assume that ψ already includes a factor that ensures that (in one dimension) Ύ ∞ −∞ ψ*ψ dx = 1 (8.17a) In three dimensions, the wavefunction is normalized if Ύ ∞ −∞ Ύ ∞ −∞ Ύ ∞ −∞ ψ*ψ dxdydz = 1 (8.17b) or, more succinctly, if Ύψ*ψ dτ = 1 (8.17c) where dτ = dxdydz and the limits of this definite integral are not written explicitly: in all such integrals, the integration is over all the space accessible to the particle. For systems with spherical symmetry it is best to work in spherical polar coordinates r, θ, and φ (Fig. 8.22): x = r sin θ cos φ, y = r sin θ sin φ, z = r cos θ. The volume element in spherical polar coordinates is dτ = r2 sin θ drdθdφ. To cover all space, the radius r ranges from 0 to ∞, the colatitude, θ, ranges from 0 to π, and the azimuth, φ, ranges from 0 to 2π (Fig. 8.23), so the explicit form of eqn 6.17c is Ύ ∞ 0 Ύ π 0 Ύ 2π 0 ψ*ψr2 sin θdrdθdφ = 1 (8.17d) Example 8.4 Normalizing a wavefunction Normalize the wavefunction used for the hydrogen atom in Example 8.3. Method We need to find the factor N that guarantees that the integral in eqn 8.17c is equal to 1. Because the system is spherical, it is most convenient to use spherical coordinates and to carry out the integrations specified in eqn 8.17d. Note that the D F A C 1 z x y r f rd dr r sin dq q q f Fig. 8.22 The spherical polar coordinates used for discussing systems with spherical symmetry. 8.4 THE BORN INTERPRETATION OF THE WAVEFUNCTION 259 Comment 8.7 Infinitely sharp spikes are acceptable provided they have zero width, so it is more appropriate to state that the wavefunction must not be infinite over any finite region. In elementary quantum mechanics the simpler restriction, to finite ψ, is sufficient. limits on the first integral sign refer to r, those on the second to θ, and those on the third to φ. A useful integral for calculations on atomic wavefunctions is Ύ ∞ 0 xn e−ax dx = where n! denotes a factorial: n! = n(n − 1)(n − 2) . . . 1. Answer The integration required is the product of three factors: 1– 4a3 0 2 2π Ύψ*ψdτ = N2 Ύ ∞ 0 r2 e−2r/a0 dr Ύ π 0 sin θ dθΎ 2π 0 dφ = πa3 0N2 Therefore, for this integral to equal 1, we must set N = 1/2 and the normalized wavefunction is ψ = 1/2 e−r/a0 Note that, because a0 is a length, the dimensions of ψ are 1/length3/2 and therefore those of ψ2 are 1/length3 (for instance, 1/m3 ) as is appropriate for a probability density. If Example 8.3 is now repeated, we can obtain the actual probabilities of finding the electron in the volume element at each location, not just their relative values. Given (from Section 10.1) that a0 = 52.9 pm, the results are (a) 2.2 × 10−6 , corresponding to 1 chance in about 500 000 inspections of finding the electron in the test volume, and (b) 2.9 × 10−7 , corresponding to 1 chance in 3.4 million. Self-test 8.4 Normalize the wavefunction given in Self-test 8.3. [N = (8/πa0 3 )1/2 ] (b) Quantization The Born interpretation puts severe restrictions on the acceptability of wavefunctions. The principal constraint is that ψ must not be infinite anywhere. If it were, the integral in eqn 8.17 would be infinite (in other words, ψ would not be square-integrable) and the normalization constant would be zero. The normalized function would then be zero everywhere, except where it is infinite, which would be unacceptable. The requirement that ψ is finite everywhere rules out many possible solutions of the Schrödinger equation, because many mathematically acceptable solutions rise to infinity and are therefore physically unacceptable. We shall meet several examples shortly. The requirement that ψ is finite everywhere is not the only restriction implied by the Born interpretation. We could imagine (and in Section 9.6a will meet) a solution of the Schrödinger equation that gives rise to more than one value of |ψ|2 at a single point. The Born interpretation implies that such solutions are unacceptable, because it would be absurd to have more than one probability that a particle is at the same point. This restriction is expressed by saying that the wavefunction must be single-valued; that is, have only one value at each point of space. D F 1 πa3 0 A C D F 1 πa3 0 A C # $ 5 4 6 4 7 5 4 6 4 7 n! an+1 260 8 QUANTUM THEORY: INTRODUCTION AND PRINCIPLES The Schrödinger equation itself also implies some mathematical restrictions on the type of functions that will occur. Because it is a second-order differential equation, the second derivative of ψ must be well-defined if the equation is to be applicable everywhere. We can take the second derivative of a function only if it is continuous (so there are no sharp steps in it, Fig. 8.24) and if its first derivative, its slope, is continuous (so there are no kinks). At this stage we see that ψ must be continuous, have a continuous slope, be single-valued, and be square-integrable. An acceptable wavefunction cannot be zero everywhere, because the particle it describes must be somewhere. These are such severe restrictions that acceptable solutions of the Schrödinger equation do not in general exist for arbitrary values of the energy E. In other words, a particle may possess only certain energies, for otherwise its wavefunction would be physically unacceptable. That is, the energy of a particle is quantized. We can find the acceptable energies by solving the Schrödinger equation for motion of various kinds, and selecting the solutions that conform to the restrictions listed above. That is the task of the next chapter. Quantum mechanical principles We have claimed that a wavefunction contains all the information it is possible to obtain about the dynamical properties of the particle (for example, its location and momentum). We have seen that the Born interpretation tells us as much as we can know about location, but how do we find any additional information? 8.5 The information in a wavefunction The Schrödinger equation for a particle of mass m free to move parallel to the x-axis with zero potential energy is obtained from eqn 8.13 by setting V = 0, and is − = Eψ (8.18) The solutions of this equation have the form ψ = Aeikx + Be−ikx Ε = (8.19) where A and B are constants. To verify that ψ is a solution of eqn 8.18, we simply substitute it into the left-hand side of the equation and confirm that we obtain Eψ: − = − (Aeikx + Be−kx ) = − {A(ik)2 eikx + B(−ik)2 e−ikx } = (Aeikx + Be−ikx ) = Eψ (a) The probability density We shall see later what determines the values of A and B; for the time being we can treat them as arbitrary constants. Suppose that B = 0 in eqn 8.19, then the wavefunction is simply ψ = Aeikx (8.20) $2 k2 2m $2 2m d2 dx2 $2 2m d2 ψ dx2 $2 2m k2 $2 2m d2 ψ dx2 $2 2m (a) (b) (c) (d) y ¥ ¥ x Fig. 8.24 The wavefunction must satisfy stringent conditions for it to be acceptable. (a) Unacceptable because it is not continuous; (b) unacceptable because its slope is discontinuous; (c) unacceptable because it is not single-valued; (d) unacceptable because it is infinite over a finite region. Comment 8.8 There are cases, and we shall meet them, where acceptable wavefunctions have kinks. These cases arise when the potential energy has peculiar properties, such as rising abruptly to infinity. When the potential energy is smoothly well-behaved and finite, the slope of the wavefunction must be continuous; if the potential energy becomes infinite, then the slope of the wavefunction need not be continuous. There are only two cases of this behaviour in elementary quantum mechanics, and the peculiarity will be mentioned when we meet them. 8.5 THE INFORMATION IN A WAVEFUNCTION 261 Im e = sin ikx kx Re e = cos ikx kx | | 2 = 1 cos kx cos2 kx y (a) (b) Fig. 8.25 (a) The square modulus of a wavefunction corresponding to a definite state of linear momentum is a constant; so it corresponds to a uniform probability of finding the particle anywhere. (b) The probability distribution corresponding to the superposition of states of equal magnitude of linear momentum but opposite direction of travel. Comment 8.9 If the probability density of a particle is a constant, then it follows that, with x ranging from −∞ to +∞, the normalization constants, A or B, are 0. To avoid this embarrassing problem, x is allowed to range from −L to +L, and L is allowed to go to infinity at the end of all calculations. We ignore this complication here. Where is the particle? To find out, we calculate the probability density: |ψ|2 = (Aeikx )*(Aeikx ) = (A*e−ikx )(Aeikx ) = |A|2 (8.21) This probability density is independent of x; so, wherever we look along the x-axis, there is an equal probability of finding the particle (Fig. 8.25a). In other words, if the wavefunction of the particle is given by eqn 8.20, then we cannot predict where we will find the particle. The same would be true if the wavefunction in eqn 8.19 had A = 0; then the probability density would be |B |2 , a constant. Now suppose that in the wavefunction A = B. Then eqn 8.19 becomes ψ = A(eikx + e−ikx ) = 2A cos kx (8.22) The probability density now has the form |ψ|2 = (2A cos kx)*(2A cos kx) = 4|A|2 cos2 kx (8.23) This function is illustrated in Fig. 8.25b. As we see, the probability density periodically varies between 0 and 4|A|2 . The locations where the probability density is zero correspond to nodes in the wavefunction: particles will never be found at the nodes. Specifically, a node is a point where a wavefunction passes through zero. The location where a wavefunction approaches zero without actually passing through zero is not a node. Nodes are defined in terms of the probability amplitude, the wavefunction itself. The probability density, of course, never passes through zero because it cannot be negative. (b) Operators, eigenvalues, and eigenfunctions To formulate a systematic way of extracting information from the wavefunction, we first note that any Schrödinger equation (such as those in eqns 8.13 and 8.18) may be written in the succinct form @ψ = Eψ (8.24a) with (in one dimension) @ = − + V(x) (8.24b) The quantity @ is an operator, something that carries out a mathematical operation on the function ψ. In this case, the operation is to take the second derivative of ψ and (after multiplication by −$2 /2m) to add the result to the outcome of multiplying ψ by V. The operator @ plays a special role in quantum mechanics, and is called the hamiltonianoperatorafter the nineteenth century mathematician William Hamilton, who developed a form of classical mechanics that, it subsequently turned out, is well suited to the formulation of quantum mechanics. The hamiltonian operator is the operator corresponding to the total energy of the system, the sum of the kinetic and potential energies. Consequently, we can infer—as we anticipated in Section 8.3— that the first term in eqn 8.24b (the term proportional to the second derivative) must be the operator for the kinetic energy. When the Schrödinger equation is written as in eqn 8.24a, it is seen to be an eigenvalue equation, an equation of the form (Operator)(function) = (constant factor) × (same function) (8.25a) If we denote a general operator by ) (where Ω is uppercase omega) and a constant factor by ω (lowercase omega), then an eigenvalue equation has the form )ψ = ωψ (8.25b) d2 dx2 $2 2m 262 8 QUANTUM THEORY: INTRODUCTION AND PRINCIPLES The factor ω is called the eigenvalue of the operator ). The eigenvalue in eqn 8.24a is the energy. The function ψ in an equation of this kind is called an eigenfunction of the operator ) and is different for each eigenvalue. The eigenfunction in eqn 8.24a is the wavefunction corresponding to the energy E. It follows that another way of saying ‘solve the Schrödinger equation’ is to say ‘find the eigenvalues and eigenfunctions of the hamiltonian operator for the system’. The wavefunctions are the eigenfunctions of the hamiltonian operator, and the corresponding eigenvalues are the allowed energies. Example 8.5 Identifying an eigenfunction Show that eax is an eigenfunction of the operator d/dx, and find the corresponding eigenvalue. Show that eax2 is not an eigenfunction of d/dx. Method We need to operate on the function with the operator and check whether the result is a constant factor times the original function. Answer For ) = d/dx and ψ = eax : )ψ = eax = aeax = aψ Therefore eax is indeed an eigenfunction of d/dx, and its eigenvalue is a. For ψ = eax2 , )ψ = eax2 = 2axeax2 = 2ax × ψ which is not an eigenvalue equation even though the same function ψ occurs on the right, because ψ is now multiplied by a variable factor (2ax), not a constant factor. Alternatively, if the right-hand side is written 2a(xeax2 ), we see that it is a constant (2a) times a different function. Self-test 8.5 Is the function cos ax an eigenfunction of (a) d/dx, (b) d2 /dx2 ? [(a) No, (b) yes] The importance of eigenvalue equations is that the pattern (Energy operator)ψ = (energy) × ψ exemplified by the Schrödinger equation is repeated for other observables, or measurable properties of a system, such as the momentum or the electric dipole moment. Thus, it is often the case that we can write (Operator corresponding to an observable)ψ = (value of observable) × ψ The symbol ) in eqn 8.25b is then interpreted as an operator (for example, the hamiltonian, @) corresponding to an observable (for example, the energy), and the eigenvalue ω is the value of that observable (for example, the value of the energy, E). Therefore, if we know both the wavefunction ψ and the operator ) corresponding to the observable Ω of interest, and the wavefunction is an eigenfunction of the operator ), then we can predict the outcome of an observation of the property Ω (for example, an atom’s energy) by picking out the factor ω in the eigenvalue equation, eqn 8.25b. d dx d dx 8.5 THE INFORMATION IN A WAVEFUNCTION 263 Comment 8.10 The rules summarized by eqn 8.26 apply to observables that depend on spatial variables; intrinsic properties, such as spin (see Section 9.8) are treated differently. A basic postulate of quantum mechanics tells us how to set up the operator corresponding to a given observable: Observables, Ω, are represented by operators, ), built from the following position and momentum operators: X = x × Yx = [8.26] Thatis,theoperatorforlocationalongthex-axisismultiplication(ofthewavefunction) by x and the operator for linear momentum parallel to the x-axis is proportional to taking the derivative (of the wavefunction) with respect to x. Example 8.6 Determining the value of an observable What is the linear momentum of a particle described by the wavefunction in eqn 8.19 with (a) B = 0, (b) A = 0? Method We operate on ψ with the operator corresponding to linear momentum (eqn 8.26), and inspect the result. If the outcome is the original wavefunction multiplied by a constant (that is, we generate an eigenvalue equation), then the constant is identified with the value of the observable. Answer (a) With the wavefunction given in eqn 8.19 with B = 0, Yxψ = = A = B × ikeikx = k$Be−ikx = k$ψ This is an eigenvalue equation, and by comparing it with eqn 8.25b we find that px = +k$. (b) For the wavefunction with A = 0, Yxψ = = B = B × (−ik)e−ikx = −k$Be−ikx = −k$ψ The magnitude of the linear momentum is the same in each case (k$), but the signs are different: In (a) the particle is travelling to the right (positive x) but in (b) it is travelling to the left (negative x). Self-test 8.6 The operator for the angular momentum of a particle travelling in a circle in the xy-plane is Zz = ($/i)d/dφ, where φ is its angular position. What is the angular momentum of a particle described by the wavefunction e−2iφ ? [lz = −2$] We use the definitions in eqn 8.26 to construct operators for other spatial observables. For example, suppose we wanted the operator for a potential energy of the form V = 1 –2kx2 , with k a constant (later, we shall see that this potential energy describes the vibrations of atoms in molecules). Then it follows from eqn 8.26 that the operator corresponding to V is multiplication by x2 : W = 1 –2kx2 × (8.27) In normal practice, the multiplication sign is omitted. To construct the operator for kinetic energy, we make use of the classical relation between kinetic energy and linear $ i de−ikx dx $ i dψ dx $ i $ i deikx dx $ i dψ dx $ i d dx $ i 264 8 QUANTUM THEORY: INTRODUCTION AND PRINCIPLES momentum, which in one dimension is EK = px 2 /2m. Then, by using the operator for px in eqn 8.26 we find: ÊK = = − (8.28) It follows that the operator for the total energy, the hamiltonian operator, is @ = ÊK + W = − + W (8.29) with W the multiplicative operator in eqn 8.27 (or some other relevant potential energy). The expression for the kinetic energy operator, eqn 8.28, enables us to develop the point made earlier concerning the interpretation of the Schrödinger equation. In mathematics, the second derivative of a function is a measure of its curvature: a large second derivative indicates a sharply curved function (Fig. 8.26). It follows that a sharply curved wavefunction is associated with a high kinetic energy, and one with a low curvature is associated with a low kinetic energy. This interpretation is consistent with the de Broglie relation, which predicts a short wavelength (a sharply curved wavefunction) when the linear momentum (and hence the kinetic energy) is high. However, it extends the interpretation to wavefunctions that do not spread through space and resemble those shown in Fig. 8.26. The curvature of a wavefunction in general varies from place to place. Wherever a wavefunction is sharply curved, its contribution to the total kinetic energy is large (Fig. 8.27). Wherever the wavefunction is not sharply curved, its contribution to the overall kinetic energy is low. As we shall shortly see, the observed kinetic energy of the particle is an integral of all the contributions of the kinetic energy from each region. Hence, we can expect a particle to have a high kinetic energy if the average curvature of its wavefunction is high. Locally there can be both positive and negative contributions to the kinetic energy (because the curvature can be either positive, 9 , or negative, 8), but the average is always positive (see Problem 8.22). The association of high curvature with high kinetic energy will turn out to be a valuable guide to the interpretation of wavefunctions and the prediction of their shapes. For example, suppose we need to know the wavefunction of a particle with a given total energy and a potential energy that decreases with increasing x (Fig. 8.28). Because the difference E − V = EK increases from left to right, the wavefunction must become more sharply curved as x increases: its wavelength decreases as the local contributions to its kinetic energy increase. We can therefore guess that the wavefunction will look like the function sketched in the illustration, and more detailed calculation confirms this to be so. (c) Hermitian operators All the quantum mechanical operators that correspond to observables have a very special mathematical property: they are ‘hermitian’. An hermitian operatoris one for which the following relation is true: Hermiticity: Ύψi*)ψjdx = Ύψj*)ψidx * [8.30] It is easy to confirm that the position operator (x ×) is hermitian because we are free to change the order of the factors in the integrand: Ύ ∞ −∞ ψi*xψj dx = Ύ ∞ −∞ ψjxψi*dx = Ύ ∞ −∞ ψj*xψi dx *5 6 7 1 2 3 5 6 7 1 2 3 d2 dx2 $2 2m d2 dx2 $2 2m D F d dx $ i A C D F d dx $ i A C 1 2mHigh curvature, high kinetic energy Low curvature, low kinetic energy Fig. 8.26 Even if a wavefunction does not have the form of a periodic wave, it is still possible to infer from it the average kinetic energy of a particle by noting its average curvature. This illustration shows two wavefunctions: the sharply curved function corresponds to a higher kinetic energy than the less sharply curved function. Region contributes high kinetic energy Region contributes low kinetic energy Wavefunction, Position, x y Fig. 8.27 The observed kinetic energy of a particle is an average of contributions from the entire space covered by the wavefunction. Sharply curved regions contribute a high kinetic energy to the average; slightly curved regions contribute only a small kinetic energy. Comment 8.11 We are using the term ‘curvature’ informally: the precise technical definition of the curvature of a function f is (d2 f/dx2 )/{1 + (df/dx)2 }3/2 . 8.5 THE INFORMATION IN A WAVEFUNCTION 265 V x E Kinetic energy, EK Wavefunction,Energyy Fig. 8.28 The wavefunction of a particle in a potential decreasing towards the right and hence subjected to a constant force to the right. Only the real part of the wavefunction is shown, the imaginary part is similar, but displaced to the right. The demonstration that the linear momentum operator is hermitian is more involved because we cannot just alter the order of functions we differentiate, but it is hermitian, as we show in the following Justification. Justification 8.2 The hermiticity of the linear momentum operator Our task is to show that Ύ ∞ −∞ ψi*Yxψjdx = Ύ ∞ −∞ ψj*Yxψidx * with Yx given in eqn 8.26. To do so, we use ‘integration by parts’, the relation Ύf dx = fg − Ύg dx In the present case we write Ύ ∞ −∞ ψi*Yxψjdx = Ύ ∞ −∞ ψi* dx = ψi*ψj ∞ −∞ − Ύ ∞ −∞ ψj dx The first term on the right is zero, because all wavefunctions are zero at infinity in either direction, so we are left with Ύ ∞ −∞ ψi*Yxψjdx = − Ύ ∞ −∞ ψj dx = Ύ ∞ −∞ ψ*j dx * = Ύ ∞ −∞ ψj*Yxψidx * as we set out to prove. Self-test 8.7 Confirm that the operator d2 /dx2 is hermitian. Hermitian operators are enormously important by virtue of two properties: their eigenvalues are real (as we prove in the Justification below), and their eigenfunctions are ‘orthogonal’. All observables have real values (in the mathematical sense, such as x = 2 m and E = 10 J), so all observables are represented by hermitian operators. To say that two different functions ψi and ψj are orthogonal means that the integral (over all space) of their product is zero: Orthogonality: Ύψi*ψj dτ = 0 [8.31] For example, the hamiltonian operator is hermitian (it corresponds to an observable, the energy). Therefore, if ψ1 corresponds to one energy, and ψ2 corresponds to a different energy, then we know at once that the two functions are orthogonal and that the integral of their product is zero. 5 6 7 1 2 3 5 6 7 dψi dx $ i 1 2 3 dψi* dx $ i dψi* dx $ i $ i dψj dx $ i df dx dg dx 5 6 7 1 2 3 266 8 QUANTUM THEORY: INTRODUCTION AND PRINCIPLES Justification 8.3 The reality of eigenvalues For a wavefunction ψ that is normalized and is an eigenfunction of an hermitian operator ) with eigenvalue ω, we can write Ύψ*)ψdτ = Ύψ*ωψdτ = ωΎψ*ψdτ = ω However, by taking the complex conjugate we can write ω* = Ύψ*)ψdτ * = Ύψ*)ψdτ = ω where in the second equality we have used the hermiticity of ). The conclusion that ω* = ω confirms that ω is real. Illustration 8.2 Confirming orthogonality The wavefunctions sin x and sin 2x are eigenfunctions of the hermitian operator d2 /dx2 , with eigenvalues −1 and −4, respectively. To verify that the two wavefunctions are mutually orthogonal, we integrate the product (sin x)(sin 2x) over all space, which we may take to span from x = 0 to x = 2π, because both functions repeat themselves outside that range. Hence proving that the integral of their product is zero within that range implies that the integral over the whole of space is also integral (Fig. 8.29). A useful integral for this calculation is Ύsin ax sin bx dx = − + constant, if a2 ≠ b2 It follows that, for a = 1 and b = 2, and given the fact that sin 0 = 0, sin 2π = 0, and sin 6π = 0, Ύ 2π 0 (sin x)(sin 2x)dx = 0 and the two functions are mutually orthogonal. Self-test 8.8 Confirm that the functions sin x and sin 3x are mutually orthogonal. Ύ ∞ −∞ sin x sin 3xdx = 0 (d) Superpositions and expectation values Suppose now that the wavefunction is the one given in eqn 8.19 (with A = B). What is the linear momentum of the particle it describes? We quickly run into trouble if we use the operator technique. When we operate with px, we find = A = − A sin kx (8.32) This expression is not an eigenvalue equation, because the function on the right (sin kx) is different from that on the left (cos kx). 2k$ i d cos kx dx 2$ i dψ dx $ i J K L G H I sin(a + b)x 2(a + b) sin(a − b)x 2(a − b) 5 6 7 1 2 3 1 0.5 0 -0.5 -1 0 p 2 f x( ) x sin x sin 2x p Fig. 8.29 The integral of the function f(x) = sin x sin 2x is equal to the area (tinted) below the brown curve, and is zero, as can be inferred by symmetry. The function—and the value of the integral—repeats itself for all replications of the section between 0 and 2π, so the integral from −∞ to ∞ is zero. 8.5 THE INFORMATION IN A WAVEFUNCTION 267 When the wavefunction of a particle is not an eigenfunction of an operator, the property to which the operator corresponds does not have a definite value. However, in the current example the momentum is not completely indefinite because the cosine wavefunction is a linearcombination, or sum, of eikx and e−ikx , and these two functions, as we have seen, individually correspond to definite momentum states. We say that the total wavefunction is a superposition of more than one wavefunction. Symbolically we can write the superposition as ψ = ψ→ + ψ← Particle with Particle with linear linear momentum momentum +k$ −k$ The interpretation of this composite wavefunction is that, if the momentum of the particle is repeatedly measured in a long series of observations, then its magnitude will found to be k$ in all the measurements (because that is the value for each component of the wavefunction). However, because the two component wavefunctions occur equally in the superposition, half the measurements will show that the particle is moving to the right (px = +k$), and half the measurements will show that it is moving to the left (px = −k$). According to quantum mechanics, we cannot predict in which direction the particle will in fact be found to be travelling; all we can say is that, in a long series of observations, if the particle is described by this wavefunction, then there are equal probabilities of finding the particle travelling to the right and to the left. The same interpretation applies to any wavefunction written as a linear combination of eigenfunctions of an operator. Thus, suppose the wavefunction is known to be a superposition of many different linear momentum eigenfunctions and written as the linear combination ψ = c1ψ1 + c2ψ2 + · · · = ∑ k ckψk (8.33) where the ck are numerical (possibly complex) coefficients and the ψk correspond to different momentum states. The functions ψk are said to form a complete set in the sense that any arbitrary function can be expressed as a linear combination of them. Then according to quantum mechanics: 1 When the momentum is measured, in a single observation one of the eigenvalues corresponding to the ψk that contribute to the superposition will be found. 2 The probability of measuring a particular eigenvalue in a series of observations is proportional to the square modulus (|ck |2 ) of the corresponding coefficient in the linear combination. 3 The average value of a large number of observations is given by the expectation value, ͗Ω͘, of the operator ) corresponding to the observable of interest. The expectation value of an operator ) is defined as ͗Ω͘ = Ύψ*)ψdτ [8.34] This formula is valid only for normalized wavefunctions. As we see in the Justification below, an expectation value is the weighted average of a large number of observations of a property. Comment 8.12 In general, a linear combination of two functions f and g is c1f + c2g, where c1 and c2 are numerical coefficients, so a linear combination is a more general term than ‘sum’. In a sum, c1 = c2 = 1. A linear combination might have the form 0.567f + 1.234g, for instance, so it is more general than the simple sum f + g. 268 8 QUANTUM THEORY: INTRODUCTION AND PRINCIPLES Justification 8.4 The expectation value of an operator If ψ is an eigenfunction of ) with eigenvalue ω, the expectation value of ) is ωψ ͗Ω͘ = Ύψ*)ψdτ = Ύψ*ωψdτ = ω Ύψ*ψdτ = ω because ω is a constant and may be taken outside the integral, and the resulting integral is equal to 1 for a normalized wavefunction. The interpretation of this expression is that, because every observation of the property Ω results in the value ω (because the wavefunction is an eigenfunction of )), the mean value of all the observations is also ω. A wavefunction that is not an eigenfunction of the operator of interest can be written as a linear combination of eigenfunctions. For simplicity, suppose the wavefunction is the sum of two eigenfunctions (the general case, eqn 8.33, can easily be developed). Then ͗Ω͘ = Ύ(c1ψ1 + c2ψ2)*)(c1ψ1 + c2ψ2)dτ = Ύ(c1ψ1 + c2ψ2)*(c1)ψ1 + c2)ψ2)dτ = Ύ(c1ψ1 + c2ψ2)*(c1ω1ψ1 + c2ω2ψ2)dτ 1 1 = c1*c1ω1 Ύψ1*ψ1dτ + c2*c2ω2Ύψ2*ψ2dτ 0 0 + c2*c1ω1 Ύψ2*ψ1dτ + c1*c2ω2Ύψ1*ψ2dτ The first two integrals on the right are both equal to 1 because the wavefunctions are individually normalized. Because ψ1 and ψ2 correspond to different eigenvalues of an hermitian operator, they are orthogonal, so the third and fourth integrals on the right are zero. We can conclude that ͗Ω͘ = |c1 |2 ω1 + |c2 |2 ω2 This expression shows that the expectation value is the sum of the two eigenvalues weighted by the probabilities that each one will be found in a series of measurements. Hence, the expectation value is the weighted mean of a series of observations. Example 8.7 Calculating an expectation value Calculate the average value of the distance of an electron from the nucleus in the hydrogen atom in its state of lowest energy. Method The average radius is the expectation value of the operator corresponding to the distance from the nucleus, which is multiplication by r. To evaluate ͗r͘, we need to know the normalized wavefunction (from Example 8.4) and then evaluate the integral in eqn 8.34. 5 6 7 5 6 7 5 6 7 5 6 7 # $ 8.6 THE UNCERTAINTY PRINCIPLE 269 Answer The average value is given by the expectation value ͗r͘ = Ύψ*rψ dτ which we evaluate by using spherical polar coordinates. Using the normalized function in Example 8.4 gives 3!a0 3 /24 2 2π ͗r͘ = Ύ ∞ 0 r3 e−2r/a0 dr Ύ π 0 sin θ dθ Ύ 2π 0 dφ = 3 –2a0 Because a0 = 52.9 pm (see Section 10.1), ͗r͘ = 79.4 pm. This result means that, if a very large number of measurements of the distance of the electron from the nucleus are made, then their mean value will be 79.4 pm. However, each different observation will give a different and unpredictable individual result because the wavefunction is not an eigenfunction of the operator corresponding to r. Self-test 8.9 Evaluate the root mean square distance, ͗r2 ͘1/2 , of the electron from the nucleus in the hydrogen atom. [31/2 a0 = 91.6 pm] The mean kinetic energy of a particle in one dimension is the expectation value of the operator given in eqn 8.28. Therefore, we can write ͗EK͘ = Ύψ*ÊKψdτ = − Ύψ* dτ (8.35) This conclusion confirms the previous assertion that the kinetic energy is a kind of average over the curvature of the wavefunction: we get a large contribution to the observed value from regions where the wavefunction is sharply curved (so d2 ψ/dx2 is large) and the wavefunction itself is large (so that ψ* is large too). 8.6 The uncertainty principle We have seen that, if the wavefunction is Aeikx , then the particle it describes has a definite state of linear momentum, namely travelling to the right with momentum px = +k$. However, we have also seen that the position of the particle described by this wavefunction is completely unpredictable. In other words, if the momentum is specified precisely, it is impossible to predict the location of the particle. This statement is one-half of a special case of the Heisenberg uncertainty principle, one of the most celebrated results of quantum mechanics: It is impossible to specify simultaneously, with arbitrary precision, both the momentum and the position of a particle. Before discussing the principle further, we must establish its other half: that, if we know the position of a particle exactly, then we can say nothing about its momentum. The argument draws on the idea of regarding a wavefunction as a superposition of eigenfunctions, and runs as follows. If we know that the particle is at a definite location, its wavefunction must be large there and zero everywhere else (Fig. 8.30). Such a wavefunction can be created by superimposing a large number of harmonic (sine and cosine) functions, or, equivalently, a number of eikx functions. In other words, we can create a sharply localized d2 ψ dx2 $2 2m 1 πa3 0 5 6 7 5 4 6 4 7 5 4 6 4 7 y x Location of particle Fig. 8.30 The wavefunction for a particle at a well-defined location is a sharply spiked function that has zero amplitude everywhere except at the particle’s position. 270 8 QUANTUM THEORY: INTRODUCTION AND PRINCIPLES Fig. 8.31 The wavefunction for a particle with an ill-defined location can be regarded as the superposition of several wavefunctions of definite wavelength that interfere constructively in one place but destructively elsewhere. As more waves are used in the superposition (as given by the numbers attached to the curves), the location becomes more precise at the expense of uncertainty in the particle’s momentum. An infinite number of waves is needed to construct the wavefunction of a perfectly localized particle. Exploration Use mathematical software or an electronic spreadsheet to construct superpositions of cosine functions as ψ(x) = ∑ N k=1 (1/N)cos(kπx), where the constant 1/N is introduced to keep the superpositions with the same overall magnitude. Explore how the probability density ψ2 (x) changes with the value of N. 21 5 2 y x wavefunction, called a wave packet, by forming a linear combination of wavefunctions that correspond to many different linear momenta. The superposition of a few harmonic functions gives a wavefunction that spreads over a range of locations (Fig. 8.31). However, as the number of wavefunctions in the superposition increases, the wave packet becomes sharper on account of the more complete interference between the positive and negative regions of the individual waves. When an infinite number of components is used, the wave packet is a sharp, infinitely narrow spike, which corresponds to perfect localization of the particle. Now the particle is perfectly localized. However, we have lost all information about its momentum because, as we saw above, a measurement of the momentum will give a result corresponding to any one of the infinite number of waves in the superposition, and which one it will give is unpredictable. Hence, if we know the location of the particle precisely (implying that its wavefunction is a superposition of an infinite number of momentum eigenfunctions), then its momentum is completely unpredictable. A quantitative version of this result is ∆p∆q ≥ 1 –2$ (8.36a) In this expression ∆p is the ‘uncertainty’ in the linear momentum parallel to the axis q, and ∆q is the uncertainty in position along that axis. These ‘uncertainties’ are precisely defined, for they are the root mean square deviations of the properties from their mean values: ∆p = {͗p2 ͘ − ͗p͘2 }1/2 ∆q = {͗q2 ͘ − ͗q͘2 }1/2 (8.36b) If there is complete certainty about the position of the particle (∆q = 0), then the only way that eqn 8.36a can be satisfied is for ∆p = ∞, which implies complete uncertainty about the momentum. Conversely, if the momentum parallel to an axis is known exactly (∆p = 0), then the position along that axis must be completely uncertain (∆q = ∞). The p and q that appear in eqn 8.36 refer to the same direction in space. Therefore, whereas simultaneous specification of the position on the x-axis and momentum parallel to the x-axis are restricted by the uncertainty relation, simultaneous location of position on x and motion parallel to y or z are not restricted. The restrictions that the uncertainty principle implies are summarized in Table 8.2. Example 8.8 Using the uncertainty principle Suppose the speed of a projectile of mass 1.0 g is known to within 1 µm s−1 . Calculate the minimum uncertainty in its position. Method Estimate ∆p from m∆v, where ∆v is the uncertainty in the speed; then use eqn 8.36a to estimate the minimum uncertainty in position, ∆q. Answer The minimum uncertainty in position is ∆q = = = 5 × 10−26 m where we have used 1 J = 1 kg m2 s−2 . The uncertainty is completely negligible for all practical purposes concerning macroscopic objects. However, if the mass is that of an electron, then the same uncertainty in speed implies an uncertainty in 1.055 × 10−34 J s 2 × (1.0 × 10−3 kg) × (1 × 10−6 m s−1 ) $ 2m∆v 8.6 THE UNCERTAINTY PRINCIPLE 271 Table 8.2* Constraints of the uncertainty principle Variable 1 Variable 2 x y z px py pz x y z px py pz * Pairs of observables that cannot be determined simultaneously with arbitrary precision are marked with a white rectangle; all others are unrestricted. Comment 8.13 For two functions f and g, d(fg) = fdg + gdf. position far larger than the diameter of an atom (the analogous calculation gives ∆q = 60 m); so the concept of a trajectory, the simultaneous possession of a precise position and momentum, is untenable. Self-test 8.10 Estimate the minimum uncertainty in the speed of an electron in a one-dimensional region of length 2a0. [500 km s−1 ] The Heisenberg uncertainty principle is more general than eqn 8.36 suggests. It applies to any pair of observables called complementary observables, which are defined in terms of the properties of their operators. Specifically, two observables Ω1 and Ω2 are complementary if )1()2ψ) ≠ )2()1ψ) (8.37) When the effect of two operators depends on their order (as this equation implies), we say that they do not commute. The different outcomes of the effect of applying )1 and )2 in a different order are expressed by introducing the commutator of the two operators, which is defined as [)1,)2] = )1)2 − )2)1 [8.38] We can conclude from Illustration 8.3 that the commutator of the operators for position and linear momentum is [X, Yx] = i$ (8.39) Illustration 8.3 Evaluating a commutator To show that the operators for position and momentum do not commute (and hence are complementary observables) we consider the effect of XYx (that is, the effect of Yx followed by the effect on the outcome of multiplication by x) on a wavefunction ψ: XYxψ = x × Next, we consider the effect of YxX on the same function (that is, the effect of multiplication by x followed by the effect of Yx on the outcome): YxXψ = xψ = ψ + x For this step we have used the standard rule about differentiating a product of functions. The second expression is clearly different from the first, so the two operators do not commute. Subtraction of the second expression from the first gives eqn 8.39. The commutator in eqn 8.39 is of such vital significance in quantum mechanics that it is taken as a fundamental distinction between classical mechanics and quantum mechanics. In fact, this commutator may be taken as a postulate of quantum mechanics, and is used to justify the choice of the operators for position and linear momentum given in eqn 8.26. D F dψ dx A C $ i d dx $ i dψ dx $ i 272 8 QUANTUM THEORY: INTRODUCTION AND PRINCIPLES With the concept of commutator established, the Heisenberg uncertainty principle can be given its most general form. For any two pairs of observables, Ω1 and Ω2, the uncertainties (to be precise, the root mean square deviations of their values from the mean) in simultaneous determinations are related by ∆Ω1∆Ω2 ≥ 1 –2 |͗[)1,)2]͘| (8.40) We obtain the special case of eqn 8.36a when we identify the observables with x and px and use eqn 8.39 for their commutator. Complementary observables are observables with non-commuting operators. With the discovery that some pairs of observables are complementary (we meet more examples in the next chapter), we are at the heart of the difference between classical and quantum mechanics. Classical mechanics supposed, falsely as we now know, that the position and momentum of a particle could be specified simultaneously with arbitrary precision. However, quantum mechanics shows that position and momentum are complementary, and that we have to make a choice: we can specify position at the expense of momentum, or momentum at the expense of position. The realization that some observables are complementary allows us to make considerable progress with the calculation of atomic and molecular properties, but it does away with some of the most cherished concepts of classical physics. 8.7 The postulates of quantum mechanics For convenience, we collect here the postulates on which quantum mechanics is based and which have been introduced in the course of this chapter. The wavefunction. All dynamical information is contained in the wavefunction ψ for the system, which is a mathematical function found by solving the Schrödinger equation for the system. In one dimension: − + V(x)ψ = Eψ The Born interpretation. If the wavefunction of a particle has the value ψ at some point r, then the probability of finding the particle in an infinitesimal volume dτ = dxdydz at that point is proportional to |ψ|2 dτ. Acceptable wavefunctions. An acceptable wavefunction must be continuous, have a continuous first derivative, be single-valued, and be square-integrable. Observables. Observables, Ω, are represented by operators, ), built from position and momentum operators of the form X = x × Yx = or, more generally, from operators that satisfy the commutation relation [X, Yx] = i$. The Heisenberg uncertainty principle. It is impossible to specify simultaneously, with arbitrary precision, both the momentum and the position of a particle and, more generally, any pair of observable with operators that do not commute. d dx $ i d2 ψ dx2 $2 2m Comment 8.14 The ‘modulus’ notation | . . . | means take the magnitude of the term the bars enclose: for a real quantity x, |x| is the magnitude of x (its value without its sign); for an imaginary quantity iy, |iy| is the magnitude of y; and—most generally—for a complex quantity z = x + iy, |z| is the value of (z*z)1/2 . For example, |−2| = 2, |3i| = 3, and |−2 + 3i| = {(−2 − 3i)(−2 + 3i)}1/2 = 131/2 . Physically, the modulus on the right of eqn 8.40 ensures that the product of uncertainties has a real, non-negative value. FURTHER READING 273 Checklist of key ideas Further reading 1. In classical physics, radiation is described in terms of an oscillating electromagnetic disturbance that travels through vacuum at a constant speed c = λν. 2. A black body is an object that emits and absorbs all frequencies of radiation uniformly. 3. The variation of the energy output of a black body with wavelength is explained by invoking quantization of energy, the limitation of energies to discrete values, which in turn leads to the Planck distribution, eqn 8.5. 4. The variation of the molar heat capacity of a solid with temperature is explained by invoking quantization of energy, which leads to the Einstein and Debye formulas, eqns 8.7 and 8.9. 5. Spectroscopic transitions are changes in populations of quantized energy levels of a system involving the absorption, emission, or scattering of electromagnetic radiation, ∆E = hν. 6. The photoelectric effect is the ejection of electrons from metals when they are exposed to ultraviolet radiation: 1–2 mev2 = hν − Φ, where Φ is the work function, the energy required to remove an electron from the metal to infinity. 7. The photoelectric effect and electron diffraction are phenomena that confirm wave–particle duality, the joint particle and wave character of matter and radiation. 8. The de Broglie relation, λ = h/p, relates the momentum of a particle with its wavelength. 9. A wavefunction is a mathematical function obtained by solving the Schrödinger equation and which contains all the dynamical information about a system. 10. The time-independent Schrödinger equation in one dimension is −($2 /2m)(d2 ψ/dx2 ) + V(x)ψ = Eψ. Articles and texts P.W. Atkins, Quanta: A handbook of concepts. Oxford University Press (1991). P.W. Atkins and R.S. Friedman, Molecular quantum mechanics. Oxford University Press (2005). D. Bohm, Quantum theory. Dover, New York (1989). 11. The Born interpretation of the wavefunction states that the value of |ψ|2 , the probability density, at a point is proportional to the probability of finding the particle at that point. 12. Quantization is the confinement of a dynamical observable to discrete values. 13. An acceptable wavefunction must be continuous, have a continuous first derivative, be single-valued, and be square-integrable. 14. An operator is something that carries out a mathematical operation on a function. The position and momentum operators are X = x × and Yx = ($/i)d/dx, respectively. 15. The hamiltonian operator is the operator for the total energy of a system, @ψ = Eψ and is the sum of the operators for kinetic energy and potential energy. 16. An eigenvalue equation is an equation of the form )ψ = ωψ. The eigenvalue is the constant ω in the eigenvalue equation; the eigenfunction is the function ψ in the eigenvalue equation. 17. The expectation value of an operator is ͗Ω͘ = ∫ψ*)ψdτ. 18. An hermitian operator is one for which ∫ψi*)ψjdx = (∫ψj*)ψidx)*. The eigenvalues of hermitian operators are real and correspond to observables, measurable properties of a system. The eigenfunctions of hermitian operations are orthogonal, meaning that ∫ψi*ψj dτ = 0. 19. The Heisenberg uncertainty principle states that it is impossible to specify simultaneously, with arbitrary precision, both the momentum and the position of a particle; ∆p∆q ≥ 1–2 $. 20. Two operators commute when [)1,)2] = )1)2 − )2)1 = 0. 21. Complementary observables are observables corresponding to non-commuting operators. 22. The general form of the Heisenberg uncertainty principle is ∆Ω1∆Ω2 ≥ 1–2 |͗[)1,)2]͘|. R.P. Feynman, R.B. Leighton, and M. Sands, The Feynman lectures on physics. Volume III. Addison–Wesley, Reading (1965). C.S. Johnson, Jr. and L.G. Pedersen, Problems and solutions in quantum chemistry and physics. Dover, New York, 1986. L. Pauling and E.B. Wilson, Introduction to quantum mechanics with applications to chemistry. Dover, New York (1985). 274 8 QUANTUM THEORY: INTRODUCTION AND PRINCIPLES Exercises 8.1a To what speed must an electron be accelerated for it to have a wavelength of 3.0 cm? 8.1b To what speed must a proton be accelerated for it to have a wavelength of 3.0 cm? 8.2a The fine-structure constant, α, plays a special role in the structure of matter; its approximate value is 1/137. What is the wavelength of an electron travelling at a speed αc, where c is the speed of light? (Note that the circumference of the first Bohr orbit in the hydrogen atom is 331 pm.) 8.2b Calculate the linear momentum of photons of wavelength 350 nm. What speed does a hydrogen molecule need to travel to have the same linear momentum? 8.3a The speed of a certain proton is 0.45 Mm s−1 . If the uncertainty in its momentum is to be reduced to 0.0100 per cent, what uncertainty in its location must be tolerated? 8.3b The speed of a certain electron is 995 km s−1 . If the uncertainty in its momentum is to be reduced to 0.0010 per cent, what uncertainty in its location must be tolerated? 8.4a Calculate the energy per photon and the energy per mole of photons for radiation of wavelength (a) 600 nm (red), (b) 550 nm (yellow), (c) 400 nm (blue). 8.4b Calculate the energy per photon and the energy per mole of photons for radiation of wavelength (a) 200 nm (ultraviolet), (b) 150 pm (X-ray), (c) 1.00 cm (microwave). 8.5a Calculate the speed to which a stationary H atom would be accelerated if it absorbed each of the photons used in Exercise 8.4a. 8.5b Calculate the speed to which a stationary 4 He atom (mass 4.0026 u) would be accelerated if it absorbed each of the photons used in Exercise 8.4b. 8.6a A glow-worm of mass 5.0 g emits red light (650 nm) with a power of 0.10 W entirely in the backward direction. To what speed will it have accelerated after 10 y if released into free space and assumed to live? 8.6b A photon-powered spacecraft of mass 10.0 kg emits radiation of wavelength 225 nm with a power of 1.50 kW entirely in the backward direction. To what speed will it have accelerated after 10.0 y if released into free space? 8.7a A sodium lamp emits yellow light (550 nm). How many photons does it emit each second if its power is (a) 1.0 W, (b) 100 W? 8.7b A laser used to read CDs emits red light of wavelength 700 nm. How many photons does it emit each second if its power is (a) 0.10 W, (b) 1.0 W? 8.8a The work function for metallic caesium is 2.14 eV. Calculate the kinetic energy and the speed of the electrons ejected by light of wavelength (a) 700 nm, (b) 300 nm. 8.8b The work function for metallic rubidium is 2.09 eV. Calculate the kinetic energy and the speed of the electrons ejected by light of wavelength (a) 650 nm, (b) 195 nm. 8.9a Calculate the size of the quantum involved in the excitation of (a) an electronic oscillation of period 1.0 fs, (b) a molecular vibration of period 10 fs, (c) a pendulum of period 1.0 s. Express the results in joules and kilojoules per mole. 8.9b Calculate the size of the quantum involved in the excitation of (a) an electronic oscillation of period 2.50 fs, (b) a molecular vibration of period 2.21 fs, (c) a balance wheel of period 1.0 ms. Express the results in joules and kilojoules per mole. 8.10a Calculate the de Broglie wavelength of (a) a mass of 1.0 g travelling at 1.0 cm s−1 , (b) the same, travelling at 100 km s−1 , (c) an He atom travelling at 1000 m s−1 (a typical speed at room temperature). 8.10b Calculate the de Broglie wavelength of an electron accelerated from rest through a potential difference of (a) 100 V, (b) 1.0 kV, (c) 100 kV. 8.11a Confirm that the operator Zz = ($/i)d/dφ, where φ is an angle, is hermitian. 8.11b Show that the linear combinations  + iU and  − iU are not hermitian if  and U are hermitian operators. 8.12a Calculate the minimum uncertainty in the speed of a ball of mass 500 g that is known to be within 1.0 µm of a certain point on a bat. What is the minimum uncertainty in the position of a bullet of mass 5.0 g that is known to have a speed somewhere between 350.000 01 m s−1 and 350.000 00 m s−1 ? 8.12b An electron is confined to a linear region with a length of the same order as the diameter of an atom (about 100 pm). Calculate the minimum uncertainties in its position and speed. 8.13a In an X-ray photoelectron experiment, a photon of wavelength 150 pm ejects an electron from the inner shell of an atom and it emerges with a speed of 21.4 Mm s−1 . Calculate the binding energy of the electron. 8.13b In an X-ray photoelectron experiment, a photon of wavelength 121 pm ejects an electron from the inner shell of an atom and it emerges with a speed of 56.9 Mm s−1 . Calculate the binding energy of the electron. 8.14a Determine the commutators of the operators (a) d/dx and 1/x, (b) d/dx and x2 . 8.14b Determine the commutators of the operators a and a† , where a = (X + iY)/21/2 and a† = (X − iY)/21/2 . Discussion questions 8.1 Summarize the evidence that led to the introduction of quantum mechanics. 8.2 Explain why Planck’s introduction of quantization accounted for the properties of black-body radiation. 8.3 Explain why Einstein’s introduction of quantization accounted for the properties of heat capacities at low temperatures. 8.4 Describe how a wavefunction determines the dynamical properties of a system and how those properties may be predicted. 8.5 Account for the uncertainty relation between position and linear momentum in terms of the shape of the wavefunction. 8.6 Suggest how the general shape of a wavefunction can be predicted without solving the Schrödinger equation explicitly. PROBLEMS 275 Problems* Numerical problems 8.1 The Planck distribution gives the energy in the wavelength range dλ at the wavelength λ. Calculate the energy density in the range 650 nm to 655 nm inside a cavity of volume 100 cm3 when its temperature is (a) 25°C, (b) 3000°C. 8.2 For a black body, the temperature and the wavelength of emission maximum, λmax, are related by Wien’s law, λmaxT = 1 –5c2, where c2 = hc/k (see Problem 8.10). Values of λmax from a small pinhole in an electrically heated container were determined at a series of temperatures, and the results are given below. Deduce a value for Planck’s constant. θ/°C 1000 1500 2000 2500 3000 3500 λmax/nm 2181 1600 1240 1035 878 763 8.3 The Einstein frequency is often expressed in terms of an equivalent temperature θE, where θE = hν/k. Confirm that θE has the dimensions of temperature, and express the criterion for the validity of the high-temperature form of the Einstein equation in terms of it. Evaluate θE for (a) diamond, for which ν = 46.5 THz and (b) for copper, for which ν = 7.15 THz. What fraction of the Dulong and Petit value of the heat capacity does each substance reach at 25°C? 8.4 The ground-state wavefunction for a particle confined to a one-dimensional box of length L is ψ = 1/2 sin Suppose the box is 10.0 nm long. Calculate the probability that the particle is (a) between x = 4.95 nm and 5.05 nm, (b) between x = 1.95 nm and 2.05 nm, (c) between x = 9.90 nm and 10.00 nm, (d) in the right half of the box, (e) in the central third of the box. 8.5 The ground-state wavefunction of a hydrogen atom is ψ = 1/2 e−r/a0 where a0 = 53 pm (the Bohr radius). (a) Calculate the probability that the electron will be found somewhere within a small sphere of radius 1.0 pm centred on the nucleus. (b) Now suppose that the same sphere is located at r = a0. What is the probability that the electron is inside it? 8.6 The normalized wavefunctions for a particle confined to move on a circle are ψ(φ) = (1/2π)1/2 e−imφ , where m = 0, ±1, ±2, ±3, . . . and 0 ≤ φ ≤ 2π. Determine ͗φ͘. 8.7 A particle is in a state described by the wavefunction ψ(x) = (2a/π)1/4 e−ax2 , where a is a constant and −∞ ≤ x ≤ ∞. Verify that the value of the product ∆p∆x is consistent with the predictions from the uncertainty principle. 8.8 A particle is in a state described by the wavefunction ψ(x) = a1/2 e−ax , where a is a constant and 0 ≤ x ≤ ∞. Determine the expectation value of the commutator of the position and momentum operators. Theoretical problems 8.9 Demonstrate that the Planck distribution reduces to the Rayleigh–Jeans law at long wavelengths. D E F 1 πa3 0 A B C D E F πx L A B C D E F 2 L A B C 8.10 Derive Wien’s law, that λmaxT is a constant, where λmax is the wavelength corresponding to maximum in the Planck distribution at the temperature T, and deduce an expression for the constant as a multiple of the second radiation constant, c2 = hc/k. 8.11 Use the Planck distribution to deduce the Stefan–Boltzmann law that the total energy density of black-body radiation is proportional to T4 , and find the constant of proportionality. 8.12‡ Prior to Planck’s derivation of the distribution law for black-body radiation, Wien found empirically a closely related distribution function which is very nearly but not exactly in agreement with the experimental results, namely, ρ = (a/λ5 )e−b/λkT . This formula shows small deviations from Planck’s at long wavelengths. (a) By fitting Wien’s empirical formula to Planck’s at short wavelengths determine the constants a and b. (b) Demonstrate that Wien’s formula is consistent with Wien’s law (Problem 8.10) and with the Stefan–Boltzmann law (Problem 8.11). 8.13 Normalize the following wavefunctions: (a) sin(nπx/L) in the range 0 ≤ x ≤ L, where n = 1, 2, 3, . . . , (b) a constant in the range −L ≤ x ≤ L, (c) e−r/a in three-dimensional space, (d) xe−r/2a in three-dimensional space. Hint: The volume element in three dimensions is dτ = r2 dr sin θ dθ dφ, with 0 ≤ r < ∞, 0 ≤ θ ≤ π, 0 ≤ φ ≤ 2π. Use the integral in Example 8.4. 8.14 (a) Two (unnormalized) excited state wavefunctions of the H atom are (i) ψ = 2 − e−r/a0 (ii) ψ = r sin θ cos φ e−r/2a0 Normalize both functions to 1. (b) Confirm that these two functions are mutually orthogonal. 8.15 Identify which of the following functions are eigenfunctions of the operator d/dx: (a) eikx , (b) cos kx, (c) k, (d) kx, (e) e−αx2 . Give the corresponding eigenvalue where appropriate. 8.16 Determine which of the following functions are eigenfunctions of the inversion operator î (which has the effect of making the replacement x → −x): (a) x3 − kx, (b) cos kx, (c) x2 + 3x − 1. State the eigenvalue of î when relevant. 8.17 Which of the functions in Problem 8.15 are (a) also eigenfunctions of d2 /dx2 and (b) only eigenfunctions of d2 /dx2 ? Give the eigenvalues where appropriate. 8.18 A particle is in a state described by the wavefunction ψ = (cos χ)eikx + (sin χ)e−ikx , where χ (chi) is a parameter. What is the probability that the particle will be found with a linear momentum (a) +k$, (b) −k$? What form would the wavefunction have if it were 90 per cent certain that the particle had linear momentum +k$? 8.19 Evaluate the kinetic energy of the particle with wavefunction given in Problem 8.18. 8.20 Calculate the average linear momentum of a particle described by the following wavefunctions: (a) eikx , (b) cos kx, (c) e−αx2 , where in each one x ranges from −∞ to +∞. 8.21 Evaluate the expectation values of r and r2 for a hydrogen atom with wavefunctions given in Problem 8.14. 8.22 Calculate (a) the mean potential energy and (b) the mean kinetic energy of an electron in the ground state of a hydrogenic atom. D E F r a0 A B C * Problems denoted with the symbol ‡ were supplied by Charles Trapp, Carmen Giunta, and Marshall Cady. 276 8 QUANTUM THEORY: INTRODUCTION AND PRINCIPLES 8.23 Use mathematical software to construct superpositions of cosine functions and determine the probability that a given momentum will be observed. If you plot the superposition (which you should), set x = 0 at the centre of the screen and build the superposition there. Evaluate the root mean square location of the packet, ͗x2 ͘1/2 . 8.24 Show that the expectation value of an operator that can be written as the square of an hermitian operator is positive. 8.25 (a) Given that any operators used to represent observables must satisfy the commutation relation in eqn 8.38, what would be the operator for position if the choice had been made to represent linear momentum parallel to the x-axis by multiplication by the linear momentum? These different choices are all valid ‘representations’ of quantum mechanics. (b) With the identification of X in this representation, what would be the operator for 1/x? Hint. Think of 1/x as x−1 . Applications: to biology, environmental science, and astrophysics 8.26‡ The temperature of the Sun’s surface is approximately 5800 K. On the assumption that the human eye evolved to be most sensitive at the wavelength of light corresponding to the maximum in the Sun’s radiant energy distribution, determine the colour of light to which the eye is most sensitive. Hint: See Problem 8.10. 8.27 We saw in Impact I8.1 that electron microscopes can obtain images with several hundredfold higher resolution than optical microscopes because of the short wavelength obtainable from a beam of electrons. For electrons moving at speeds close to c, the speed of light, the expression for the de Broglie wavelength (eqn 8.12) needs to be corrected for relativistic effects: λ = 2meeV 1 + 1/2 where c is the speed of light in vacuum and V is the potential difference through which the electrons are accelerated. (a) Use the expression above to calculate the de Broglie wavelength of electrons accelerated through 50 kV. (b) Is the relativistic correction important? 8.28‡ Solar energy strikes the top of the Earth’s atmosphere at a rate of 343 W m−2 . About 30 per cent of this energy is reflected directly back into space by the Earth or the atmosphere. The Earth–atmosphere system absorbs the remaining energy and re-radiates it into space as black-body radiation. What is the average black-body temperature of the Earth? What is the wavelength of the most plentiful of the Earth’s black-body radiation? Hint. Use Wien’s law, Problem 8.10. 8.29‡ A star too small and cold to shine has been found by S. Kulkarni, K. Matthews, B.R. Oppenheimer, and T. Nakajima (Science 270, 1478 (1995)). The spectrum of the object shows the presence of methane, which, according to the authors, would not exist at temperatures much above 1000 K. The mass of the star, as determined from its gravitational effect on a companion star, is roughly 20 times the mass of Jupiter. The star is considered to be a brown dwarf, the coolest ever found. (a) From available thermodynamic data, test the stability of methane at temperatures above 1000 K. (b) What is λmax for this star? (c) What is the energy density of the star relative to that of the Sun (6000 K)? (d) To determine whether the star will shine, estimate the fraction of the energy density of the star in the visible region of the spectrum. 5 6 7 D E F eV 2mec2 A B C 1 2 3 h Quantum theory: techniques and applications To find the properties of systems according to quantum mechanics we need to solve the appropriate Schrödinger equation. This chapter presents the essentials of the solutions for three basic types of motion: translation, vibration, and rotation. We shall see that only certain wavefunctions and their corresponding energies are acceptable. Hence, quantization emerges as a natural consequence of the equation and the conditions imposed on it. The solutions bring to light a number of highly nonclassical, and therefore surprising, features of particles, especially their ability to tunnel into and through regions where classical physics would forbid them to be found. We also encounter a property of the electron, its spin, that has no classical counterpart. The chapter concludes with an introduction to the experimental techniques used to probe the quantization of energy in molecules. The three basic modes of motion—translation (motion through space), vibration, and rotation—all play an important role in chemistry because they are ways in which molecules store energy. Gas-phase molecules, for instance, undergo translational motion and their kinetic energy is a contribution to the total internal energy of a sample. Molecules can also store energy as rotational kinetic energy and transitions between their rotational energy states can be observed spectroscopically. Energy is also stored as molecular vibration and transitions between vibrational states are responsible for the appearance of infrared and Raman spectra. Translational motion Section 8.5 introduced the quantum mechanical description of free motion in one dimension. We saw there that the Schrödinger equation is − = Eψ (9.1a) or more succinctly @ψ = Eψ @ = − (9.1b) The general solutions of eqn 9.1 are ψk = Aeikx + Be−ikx Ek = (9.2) Note that we are now labelling both the wavefunctions and the energies (that is, the eigenfunctions and eigenvalues of @) with the index k. We can verify that these k2 $2 2m d2 dx2 $2 2m d2 ψ dx2 $2 2m 9 Translational motion 9.1 A particle in a box 9.2 Motion in two and more dimensions 9.3 Tunnelling I9.1 Impact on nanoscience: Scanning probe microscopy Vibrational motion 9.4 The energy levels 9.5 The wavefunctions Rotational motion 9.6 Rotation in two dimensions: a particle on a ring 9.7 Rotation in three dimensions: the particle on a sphere I9.2 Impact on nanoscience: Quantum dots 9.8 Spin Techniques of approximation 9.9 Time-independent perturbation theory 9.10 Time-dependent perturbation theory Checklist of key ideas Further reading Further information 9.1: Dirac notation Further information 9.2: Perturbation theory Discussion questions Exercises Problems 278 9 QUANTUM THEORY: TECHNIQUES AND APPLICATIONS functions are solutions by substituting ψk into the left-hand side of eqn 9.1a and showing that the result is equal to Ekψk. In this case, all values of k, and therefore all values of the energy, are permitted. It follows that the translational energy of a free particle is not quantized. We saw in Section 8.5b that a wavefunction of the form eikx describes a particle with linear momentum px = +k$, corresponding to motion towards positive x (to the right), and that a wavefunction of the form e−ikx describes a particle with the same magnitude of linear momentum but travelling towards negative x (to the left). That is, eikx is an eigenfunction of the operator Yx with eigenvalue +k$, and e−ikx is an eigenfunction with eigenvalue −k$. In either state, |ψ|2 is independent of x, which implies that the position of the particle is completely unpredictable. This conclusion is consistent with the uncertainty principle because, if the momentum is certain, then the position cannot be specified (the operators X and Yx do not commute, Section 8.6). 9.1 A particle in a box In this section, we consider a particle in a box, in which a particle of mass m is confined between two walls at x = 0 and x = L: the potential energy is zero inside the box but rises abruptly to infinity at the walls (Fig. 9.1). This model is an idealization of the potential energy of a gas-phase molecule that is free to move in a one-dimensional container. However, it is also the basis of the treatment of the electronic structure of metals (Chapter 20) and of a primitive treatment of conjugated molecules. The particle in a box is also used in statistical thermodynamics in assessing the contribution of the translational motion of molecules to their thermodynamic properties (Chapter 16). (a) The acceptable solutions The Schrödinger equation for the region between the walls (where V = 0) is the same as for a free particle (eqn 9.1), so the general solutions given in eqn 9.2 are also the same. However, we can us e±ix = cos x ± i sin x to write ψk = Aeikx + Be−ikx = A(cos kx + i sin kx) + B(cos kx − i sin kx) = (A + B) cos kx + (A − B)i sin kx If we absorb all numerical factors into two new coefficients C and D, then the general solutions take the form ψk(x) = C sin kx + D cos kx Ek = (9.3) For a free particle, any value of Ek corresponds to an acceptable solution. However, when the particle is confined within a region, the acceptable wavefunctions must satisfy certain boundary conditions, or constraints on the function at certain locations. As we shall see when we discuss penetration into barriers, a wavefunction decays exponentially with distance inside a barrier, such as a wall, and the decay is infinitely fast when the potential energy is infinite. This behaviour is consistent with the fact that it is physically impossible for the particle to be found with an infinite potential energy. We conclude that the wavefunction must be zero where V is infinite, at x < 0 and x > L. The continuity of the wavefunction then requires it to vanish just inside the well at x = 0 and x = L. That is, the boundary conditions are ψk(0) = 0 and ψk(L) = 0. These boundary conditions imply quantization, as we show in the following Justification. k2 $2 2m Potentialenergy,V 0 L x ¥¥ 0 Wall Wall Fig. 9.1 A particle in a one-dimensional region with impenetrable walls. Its potential energy is zero between x = 0 and x = L, and rises abruptly to infinity as soon as it touches the walls. 9.1 A PARTICLE IN A BOX 279 Justification 9.1 The energy levels and wavefunctions of a particle in a one-dimensional box For an informal demonstration of quantization, we consider each wavefunction to be adeBrogliewavethatmustfitwithinthecontainer.Thepermittedwavelengthssatisfy L = n × 1 –2λ n = 1, 2, . . . and therefore λ = with n = 1, 2, . . . According to the de Broglie relation, these wavelengths correspond to the momenta p = = The particle has only kinetic energy inside the box (where V = 0), so the permitted energies are E = = with n = 1, 2, . . . A more formal and widely applicable approach is as follows. Consider the wall at x = 0. According to eqn 9.3, ψ(0) = D (because sin 0 = 0 and cos 0 = 1). But because ψ(0) = 0 we must have D = 0. It follows that the wavefunction must be of the form ψk(x) = C sin kx. The value of ψ at the other wall (at x = L) is ψk(L) = C sin kL, which must also be zero. Taking C = 0 would give ψk(x) = 0 for all x, which would conflict with the Born interpretation (the particle must be somewhere). Therefore, kL must be chosen so that sin kL = 0, which is satisfied by kL = nπ n = 1, 2, . . . The value n = 0 is ruled out, because it implies k = 0 and ψk(x) = 0 everywhere (because sin 0 = 0), which is unacceptable. Negative values of n merely change the sign of sin kL (because sin(−x) = −sin x). The wavefunctions are therefore ψn(x) = C sin(nπx/L) n = 1, 2, . . . (At this point we have started to label the solutions with the index n instead of k.) Because k and Ek are related by eqn 9.3, and k and n are related by kL = nπ, it follows that the energy of the particle is limited to En = n2 h2 /8mL2 , the values obtained by the informal procedure. We conclude that the energy of the particle in a one-dimensional box is quantized and that this quantization arises from the boundary conditions that ψ must satisfy if it is to be an acceptable wavefunction. This is a general conclusion: the need to satisfy boundary conditions implies that only certain wavefunctions are acceptable, and hence restricts observables to discrete values. So far, only energy has been quantized; shortly we shall see that other physical observables may also be quantized. (b) Normalization Before discussing the solution in more detail, we shall complete the derivation of the wavefunctions by finding the normalization constant (here written C and regarded as real, that is, does not contain i). To do so, we look for the value of C that ensures that the integral of ψ2 over all the space available to the particle (that is, from x = 0 to x = L) is equal to 1: Ύ L 0 ψ2 dx = C2 Ύ L 0 sin2 = C2 × = 1, so C = 1/2 D F 2 L A C L 2 nπx L n2 h2 8mL2 p2 2m nh 2L h λ 2L n 280 9 QUANTUM THEORY: TECHNIQUES AND APPLICATIONS 1 4 9 16 25 36 49 64 81 100 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 EhmL/(/8) 22 n 0 Classically allowed energies Fig. 9.2 The allowed energy levels for a particle in a box. Note that the energy levels increase as n2 , and that their separation increases as the quantum number increases. Fig. 9.3 The first five normalized wavefunctions of a particle in a box. Each wavefunction is a standing wave, and successive functions possess one more half wave and a correspondingly shorter wavelength. Exploration Plot the probability density for a particle in a box with n = 1, 2, . . . 5 and n = 50. How do your plots illustrate the correspondence principle? 12345 y x Comment 9.1 It is sometimes useful to write cos x = (eix + e−ix )/2 sin x = (eix − e−ix )/2i for all n. Therefore, the complete solution to the problem is En = n = 1, 2, . . . (9.4a) ψn(x) = 1/2 sin for 0 ≤ x ≤ L (9.4b) Self-test 9.1 Provide the intermediate steps for the determination of the normalization constant C. Hint. Use the standard integral ∫ sin2 ax dx = 1 –2x − (1 –4a) sin 2ax + constant and the fact that sin 2mπ = 0, with m = 0, 1, 2, . . . . The energies and wavefunctions are labelled with the ‘quantum number’ n. A quantumnumberis an integer (in some cases, as we shall see, a half-integer) that labels the state of the system. For a particle in a box there is an infinite number of acceptable solutions, and the quantum number n specifies the one of interest (Fig. 9.2). As well as acting as a label, a quantum number can often be used to calculate the energy corresponding to the state and to write down the wavefunction explicitly (in the present example, by using eqn 9.4). (c) The properties of the solutions Figure 9.3 shows some of the wavefunctions of a particle in a box: they are all sine functions with the same amplitude but different wavelengths. Shortening the wavelength results in a sharper average curvature of the wavefunction and therefore an increase in the kinetic energy of the particle. Note that the number of nodes (points where the wavefunction passes through zero) also increases as n increases, and that the wavefunction ψn has n − 1 nodes. Increasing the number of nodes between walls of a given separation increases the average curvature of the wavefunction and hence the kinetic energy of the particle. The linear momentum of a particle in a box is not well defined because the wavefunction sin kx is a standing wave and, like the example of cos kx treated in Section 8.5d, not an eigenfunction of the linear momentum operator. However, each wavefunction is a superposition of momentum eigenfunctions: ψn = 1/2 sin = 1/2 (eikx − e−ikx ) k = (9.5) It follows that measurement of the linear momentum will give the value +k$ for half the measurements of momentum and −k$ for the other half. This detection of opposite directions of travel with equal probability is the quantum mechanical version of the classical picture that a particle in a box rattles from wall to wall, and in any given period spends half its time travelling to the left and half travelling to the right. Self-test 9.2 What is (a) the average value of the linear momentum of a particle in a box with quantum number n, (b) the average value of p2 ? [(a) ͗p͘ = 0, (b) ͗p2 ͘ = n2 h2 /4L2 ] Because n cannot be zero, the lowest energy that the particle may possess is not zero (as would be allowed by classical mechanics, corresponding to a stationary particle) but nπ L D F 2 L A C 1 2i nπx L D F 2 L A C D F nπx L A C D F 2 L A C n2 h2 8mL2 9.1 A PARTICLE IN A BOX 281 E1 = (9.6) This lowest, irremovable energy is called the zero-point energy. The physical origin of the zero-point energy can be explained in two ways. First, the uncertainty principle requires a particle to possess kinetic energy if it is confined to a finite region: the location of the particle is not completely indefinite, so its momentum cannot be precisely zero. Hence it has nonzero kinetic energy. Second, if the wavefunction is to be zero at the walls, but smooth, continuous, and not zero everywhere, then it must be curved, and curvature in a wavefunction implies the possession of kinetic energy. The separation between adjacent energy levels with quantum numbers n and n + 1 is En+1 − En = − = (2n + 1) (9.7) This separation decreases as the length of the container increases, and is very small when the container has macroscopic dimensions. The separation of adjacent levels becomes zero when the walls are infinitely far apart. Atoms and molecules free to move in normal laboratory-sized vessels may therefore be treated as though their translational energy is not quantized. The translational energy of completely free particles (those not confined by walls) is not quantized. Illustration 9.1 Accounting for the electronic absorption spectra of polyenes β-Carotene (1) is a linear polyene in which 10 single and 11 double bonds alternate along a chain of 22 carbon atoms. If we take each CC bond length to be about 140 pm, then the length L of the molecular box in β-carotene is L = 0.294 nm. For reasons that will be familiar from introductory chemistry, each C atom contributes one p-electron to the π orbitals and, in the lowest energy state of the molecule, each level up to n = 11 is occupied by two electrons. From eqn 9.7 it follows that the separation in energy between the ground state and the state in which one electron is promoted from n = 11 to n = 12 is ∆E = E12 − E11 = (2 × 11 + 1) = 1.60 × 10−19 J It follows from the Bohr frequency condition (eqn 8.10, ∆E = hν) that the frequency of radiation required to cause this transition is ν = = = 2.41 × 1014 s−1 The experimental value is ν = 6.03 × 1014 s−1 (λ = 497 nm), corresponding to radiation in the visible range of the electromagnetic spectrum. Self-test 9.3 Estimate a typical nuclear excitation energy by calculating the first excitation energy of a proton confined to a square well with a length equal to the diameter of a nucleus (approximately 1 fm). [0.6 GeV] 1.60 × 10−19 J 6.626 × 10−34 J s ∆E h (6.626 × 10−34 J s)2 8 × (9.110 × 10−31 kg) × (2.94 × 10−10 m)2 h2 8mL2 n2 h2 8mL2 (n + 1)2 h2 8mL2 h2 8mL2 282 9 QUANTUM THEORY: TECHNIQUES AND APPLICATIONS n = 1 n = 1 n = 1 n = 2 n = 2 n = 2 (a) (c) (b) Wall Wall Fig. 9.4 (a) The first two wavefunctions, (b) the corresponding probability distributions, and (c) a representation of the probability distribution in terms of the darkness of shading. The probability density for a particle in a box is ψ2 (x) = sin2 (9.8) and varies with position. The nonuniformity is pronounced when n is small (Fig. 9.4), but—provided we ignore the increasingly rapid oscillations—ψ2 (x) becomes more uniform as n increases. The distribution at high quantum numbers reflects the classical result that a particle bouncing between the walls spends, on the average, equal times at all points. That the quantum result corresponds to the classical prediction at high quantum numbers is an illustration of the correspondence principle, which states that classical mechanics emerges from quantum mechanics as high quantum numbers are reached. Example 9.1 Using the particle in a box solutions The wavefunctions of an electron in a conjugated polyene can be approximated by particle-in-a-box wavefunctions. What is the probability, P, of locating the electron between x = 0 (the left-hand end of a molecule) and x = 0.2 nm in its lowest energy state in a conjugated molecule of length 1.0 nm? Method The value of ψ2 dx is the probability of finding the particle in the small region dx located at x; therefore, the total probability of finding the electron in the specified region is the integral of ψ2 dx over that region. The wavefunction of the electron is given in eqn 9.4b with n = 1. Answer The probability of finding the particle in a region between x = 0 and x = l is P = Ύ l 0 ψ2 n dx = Ύ l 0 sin2 dx = − sin We then set n = 1 and l = 0.2 nm, which gives P = 0.05. The result corresponds to a chance of 1 in 20 of finding the electron in the region. As n becomes infinite, the sine term, which is multiplied by 1/n, makes no contribution to P and the classical result, P = l/L, is obtained. Self-test 9.4 Calculate the probability that an electron in the state with n = 1 will be found between x = 0.25L and x = 0.75L in a conjugated molecule of length L (with x = 0 at the left-hand end of the molecule). [0.82] (d) Orthogonality We can now illustrate a property of wavefunctions first mentioned in Section 8.5. Two wavefunctions are orthogonal if the integral of their product vanishes. Specifically, the functions ψn and ψn′ are orthogonal if Ύψn*ψn′dτ = 0 (9.9) where the integration is over all space. A general feature of quantum mechanics, which we prove in the Justification below, is that wavefunctions corresponding to different energies are orthogonal; therefore, we can be confident that all the wavefunctions of a particle in a box are mutually orthogonal. A more compact notation for integrals of this kind is described in Further information 9.1. 2πnl L 1 2nπ l L nπx L 2 L nπx L 2 L 9.2 MOTION IN TWO AND MORE DIMENSIONS 283 1 3 1 3* x L0 y y y y Fig. 9.5 Two functions are orthogonal if the integral of their product is zero. Here the calculation of the integral is illustrated graphically for two wavefunctions of a particle in a square well. The integral is equal to the total area beneath the graph of the product, and is zero. Justification 9.2 The orthogonality of wavefunctions Suppose we have two wavefunctions ψn and ψm corresponding to two different energies En and Em, respectively. Then we can write @ψn = Enψn @ψm = Emψm Now multiply the first of these two Schrödinger equations by ψ*m and the second by ψn* and integrate over all space: Ύψ*m@ψndτ = EnΎψ*mψndτ Ύψ*n@ψmdτ = EmΎψ*nψmdτ Next, noting that the energies themselves are real, form the complex conjugate of the second expression (for the state m) and subtract it from the first expression (for the state n): Ύψ*m@ψndτ − Ύψ*n@ψmdτ * = EnΎψ*mψndτ − EmΎψnψ*mdτ By the hermiticity of the hamiltonian (Section 8.5c), the two terms on the left are equal, so they cancel and we are left with 0 = (En − Em)Ύψ*mψndτ However, the two energies are different; therefore the integral on the right must be zero, which confirms that two wavefunctions belonging to different energies are orthogonal. Illustration 9.2 Verifying the orthogonality of the wavefunctions for a particle in a box We can verify the orthogonality of wavefunctions of a particle in a box with n = 1 and n = 3 (Fig. 9.5): Ύ L 0 ψ*1ψ3dx = Ύ L 0 sin sin dx = 0 We have used the standard integral given in Illustration 8.2. The property of orthogonality is of great importance in quantum mechanics because it enables us to eliminate a large number of integrals from calculations. Orthogonality plays a central role in the theory of chemical bonding (Chapter 11) and spectroscopy (Chapter 14). Sets of functions that are normalized and mutually orthogonal are called orthonormal. The wavefunctions in eqn 9.4b are orthonormal. 9.2 Motion in two and more dimensions Next, we consider a two-dimensional version of the particle in a box. Now the particle isconfinedtoarectangularsurfaceoflengthL1 inthex-directionandL2 inthey-direction; the potential energy is zero everywhere except at the walls, where it is infinite (Fig. 9.6). The wavefunction is now a function of both x and y and the Schrödinger equation is − + = Eψ (9.10) D F ∂2 ψ ∂y2 ∂2 ψ ∂x2 A C $2 2m 3πx L πx L 2 L D E F A B C x y L1 L2 0 0 Potential energy Particle confined to surface Fig. 9.6 A two-dimensional square well. The particle is confined to the plane bounded by impenetrable walls. As soon as it touches the walls, its potential energy rises to infinity. 284 9 QUANTUM THEORY: TECHNIQUES AND APPLICATIONS We need to see how to solve this partial differential equation, an equation in more than one variable. (a) Separation of variables Some partial differential equations can be simplified by the separation of variables technique, which divides the equation into two or more ordinary differential equations, one for each variable. An important application of this procedure, as we shall see, is the separation of the Schrödinger equation for the hydrogen atom into equations that describe the radial and angular variation of the wavefunction. The technique is particularly simple for a two-dimensional square well, as can be seen by testing whether a solution of eqn 9.10 can be found by writing the wavefunction as a product of functions, one depending only on x and the other only on y: ψ(x,y) = X(x)Y(y) With this substitution, we show in the Justification below that eqn 9.10 separates into two ordinary differential equations, one for each coordinate: − = EXX − = EYY E = EX + EY (9.11) The quantity EX is the energy associated with the motion of the particle parallel to the x-axis, and likewise for EY and motion parallel to the y-axis. Justification 9.3 The separation of variables technique applied to the particle in a two-dimensional box The first step in the justification of the separability of the wavefunction into the product of two functions X and Y is to note that, because X is independent of y and Y is independent of x, we can write = = Y = = X Then eqn 9.10 becomes − Y + X = EXY When both sides are divided by XY, we can rearrange the resulting equation into + = − The first term on the left is independent of y, so if y is varied only the second term can change. But the sum of these two terms is a constant given by the right-hand side of the equation; therefore, even the second term cannot change when y is changed. In other words, the second term is a constant, which we write −2mEY/$2 . By a similar argument, the first term is a constant when x changes, and we write it −2mEX/$2 , and E = EX + EY. Therefore, we can write = − = − which rearrange into the two ordinary (that is, single variable) differential equations in eqn 9.11. 2mEY $2 d2 Y dy2 1 Y 2mEX $2 d2 X dx2 1 X 2mE $2 d2 Y dy2 1 Y d2 X dx2 1 X D E F d2 Y dy2 d2 X dx2 A B C $2 2m d2 Y dy2 ∂2 XY ∂y2 ∂2 ψ ∂y2 d2 X dx2 ∂2 XY ∂x2 ∂2 ψ ∂x2 d2 Y dy2 $2 2m d2 X dx2 $2 2m 9.2 MOTION IN TWO AND MORE DIMENSIONS 285 Each of the two ordinary differential equations in eqn 9.11 is the same as the onedimensional square-well Schrödinger equation. We can therefore adapt the results in eqn 9.4 without further calculation: Xn1 (x) = 1/2 sin Yn2 (y) = 1/2 sin Then, because ψ = XY and E = EX + EY, we obtain ψn1,n2 (x,y) = sin sin 0 ≤ x ≤ L1, 0 ≤ y ≤ L2 En1n2 = + (9.12a) with the quantum numbers taking the values n1 = 1, 2, . . . and n2 = 1, 2, . . . independently. Some of these functions are plotted in Fig. 9.7. They are the two-dimensional versions of the wavefunctions shown in Fig. 9.3. Note that two quantum numbers are needed in this two-dimensional problem. We treat a particle in a three-dimensional box in the same way. The wavefunctions have another factor (for the z-dependence), and the energy has an additional term in n3 2 /L3 2 . Solution of the Schrödinger equation by the separation of variables technique then gives ψn1,n2,n3 (x,y,z) = 1/2 sin sin sin 0 ≤ x ≤ L1, 0 ≤ y ≤ L2, 0 ≤ z ≤ L3 (9.12b) En1n2n3 = + + (b) Degeneracy An interesting feature of the solutions for a particle in a two-dimensional box is obtained when the plane surface is square, with L1 = L2 = L. Then eqn 9.12a becomes ψn1,n2 (x,y) = sin sin En1n2 = (n1 2 + n2 2) (9.13) h2 8mL2 n2πy L n1πx L 2 L h2 8m D F n2 3 L2 3 n2 2 L2 2 n1 2 L1 2 A C n3πz L3 n2πy L2 n1πx L1 D F 8 L1L2L3 A C h2 8m D F n2 2 L2 2 n1 2 L1 2 A C n2πy L2 n1πx L1 2 (L1L2)1/2 n2πy L2 D F 2 L2 A C n1πx L1 D F 2 L1 A C (a) (b) (c) (d) + -+ + + +- - Fig. 9.7 The wavefunctions for a particle confined to a rectangular surface depicted as contours of equal amplitude. (a) n1 = 1, n2 = 1, the state of lowest energy, (b) n1 = 1, n2 = 2, (c) n1 = 2, n2 = 1, and (d) n1 = 2, n2 = 2. Exploration Use mathematical software to generate threedimensional plots of the functions in this illustration. Deduce a rule for the number of nodal lines in a wavefunction as a function of the values of nx and ny. 286 9 QUANTUM THEORY: TECHNIQUES AND APPLICATIONS Consider the cases n1 = 1, n2 = 2 and n1 = 2, n2 = 1: ψ1,2 = sin sin E1,2 = ψ2,1 = sin sin E2,1 = We see that, although the wavefunctions are different, they are degenerate, meaning that they correspond to the same energy. In this case, in which there are two degenerate wavefunctions, we say that the energy level 5(h2 /8mL2 ) is ‘doubly degenerate’. The occurrence of degeneracy is related to the symmetry of the system. Figure 9.8 shows contour diagrams of the two degenerate functions ψ1,2 and ψ2,1. Because the box is square, we can convert one wavefunction into the other simply by rotating the plane by 90°. Interconversion by rotation through 90° is not possible when the plane is not square, and ψ1,2 and ψ2,1 are then not degenerate. Similar arguments account for the degeneracy of states in a cubic box. We shall see many other examples of degeneracy in the pages that follow (for instance, in the hydrogen atom), and all of them can be traced to the symmetry properties of the system (see Section 12.4b). 9.3 Tunnelling If the potential energy of a particle does not rise to infinity when it is in the walls of the container, and E < V, the wavefunction does not decay abruptly to zero. If the walls are thin (so that the potential energy falls to zero again after a finite distance), then the wavefunction oscillates inside the box, varies smoothly inside the region representing the wall, and oscillates again on the other side of the wall outside the box (Fig. 9.9). Hence the particle might be found on the outside of a container even though according to classical mechanics it has insufficient energy to escape. Such leakage by penetration through a classically forbidden region is called tunnelling. The Schrödinger equation can be used to calculate the probability of tunnelling of a particle of mass m incident on a finite barrier from the left. On the left of the barrier (for x < 0) the wavefunctions are those of a particle with V = 0, so from eqn 9.2 we can write ψ = Aeikx + Be−ikx k$ = (2mE)1/2 (9.14) The Schrödinger equation for the region representing the barrier (for 0 ≤ x ≤ L), where the potential energy is the constant V, is − + Vψ = Eψ (9.15) We shall consider particles that have E < V (so, according to classical physics, the particle has insufficient energy to pass over the barrier), and therefore V − E is positive. The general solutions of this equation are ψ = Ceκx + De−κx κ$ = {2m(V − E)}1/2 (9.16) as we can readily verify by differentiating ψ twice with respect to x. The important feature to note is that the two exponentials are now real functions, as distinct from the complex, oscillating functions for the region where V = 0 (oscillating functions would be obtained if E > V). To the right of the barrier (x > L), where V = 0 again, the wavefunctions are d2 ψ dx2 $2 2m 5h2 8mL2 πy L 2πx L 2 L 5h2 8mL2 2πy L πx L 2 L M M (a) (b) + - + Fig. 9.8 The wavefunctions for a particle confined to a square surface. Note that one wavefunction can be converted into the other by a rotation of the box by 90°. The two functions correspond to the same energy. Degeneracy and symmetry are closely related. Wavefunction E V x Fig. 9.9 A particle incident on a barrier from the left has an oscillating wave function, but inside the barrier there are no oscillations (for E < V). If the barrier is not too thick, the wavefunction is nonzero at its opposite face, and so oscillates begin again there. (Only the real component of the wavefunction is shown.) 9.3 TUNNELLING 287 ψ = A′eikx + B′e−ikx k$ = (2mE)1/2 (9.17) The complete wavefunction for a particle incident from the left consists of an incident wave, a wave reflected from the barrier, the exponentially changing amplitudes inside the barrier, and an oscillating wave representing the propagation of the particle to the right after tunnelling through the barrier successfully (Fig. 9.10). The acceptable wavefunctions must obey the conditions set out in Section 8.4b. In particular, they must be continuous at the edges of the barrier (at x = 0 and x = L, remembering that e0 = 1): A + B = C + D CeκL + De−κL = A′eikL + B′e−ikL (9.18) Their slopes (their first derivatives) must also be continuous there (Fig. 9.11): ikA − ikB = κC − κD κCeκL − κDe−κL = ikA′eikL − ikB′e−ikL (9.19) At this stage, we have four equations for the six unknown coefficients. If the particles are shot towards the barrier from the left, there can be no particles travelling to the left on the right of the barrier. Therefore, we can set B′ = 0, which removes one more unknown. We cannot set B = 0 because some particles may be reflected back from the barrier toward negative x. The probability that a particle is travelling towards positive x (to the right) on the left of the barrier is proportional to |A|2 , and the probability that it is travelling to the right on the right of the barrier is |A′|2 . The ratio of these two probabilities is called the transmission probability, T. After some algebra (see Problem 9.9) we find T = 1 + −1 (9.20a) where ε = E/V. This function is plotted in Fig. 9.12; the transmission coefficient for E > V is shown there too. For high, wide barriers (in the sense that κL >> 1), eqn 9.20a simplifies to T ≈ 16ε(1 − ε)e−2κL (9.20b) The transmission probability decreases exponentially with the thickness of the barrier and with m1/2 . It follows that particles of low mass are more able to tunnel through barriers than heavy ones (Fig. 9.13). Tunnelling is very important for electrons and muons, and moderately important for protons; for heavier particles it is less important. 5 6 7 (eκL − e−κL )2 16ε(1 − ε) 1 2 3 Incident wave Reflected wave Transmitted wave Fig. 9.10 When a particle is incident on a barrier from the left, the wavefunction consists of a wave representing linear momentum to the right, a reflected component representing momentum to the left, a varying but not oscillating component inside the barrier, and a (weak) wave representing motion to the right on the far side of the barrier. y x Fig. 9.11 The wavefunction and its slope must be continuous at the edges of the barrier. The conditions for continuity enable us to connect the wavefunctions in the three zones and hence to obtain relations between the coefficients that appear in the solutions of the Schrödinger equation. 0.5 0.4 0.3 0.2 0.1 0 0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 2 4 10 1 2 3 4 1 0.8 0.6 0.4 0.2 0 2 Transmissionprobability,T Incident energy, /E V Incident energy, /E V 10 Fig. 9.12 The transition probabilities for passage through a barrier. The horizontal axis is the energy of the incident particle expressed as a multiple of the barrier height. The curves are labelled with the value of L(2mV)1/2 /$. The graph on the left is for E < V and that on the right for E > V. Note that T > 0 for E < V whereas classically T would be zero. However, T < 1 for E > V, whereas classically T would be 1. Exploration Plot T against ε for a hydrogen molecule, a proton and an electron. V 288 9 QUANTUM THEORY: TECHNIQUES AND APPLICATIONS A number of effects in chemistry (for example, the isotope-dependence of some reaction rates) depend on the ability of the proton to tunnel more readily than the deuteron. The very rapid equilibration of proton transfer reactions is also a manifestation of the ability of protons to tunnel through barriers and transfer quickly from an acid to a base. Tunnelling of protons between acidic and basic groups is also an important feature of the mechanism of some enzyme-catalysed reactions. As we shall see in Chapters 24 and 25, electron tunnelling is one of the factors that determine the rates of electron transfer reactions at electrodes and in biological systems. A problem related to the one just considered is that of a particle in a square-well potential of finite depth (Fig. 9.14). In this kind of potential, the wavefunction penetrates into the walls, where it decays exponentially towards zero, and oscillates within the well. The wavefunctions are found by ensuring, as in the discussion of tunnelling, that they and their slopes are continuous at the edges of the potential. Some of the lowest energy solutions are shown in Fig. 9.15. A further difference from the solutions for an infinitely deep well is that there is only a finite number of bound states. Regardless of the depth and length of the well, there is always at least one bound state. Detailed consideration of the Schrödinger equation for the problem shows that in general the number of levels is equal to N, with N − 1 < < N (9.21) where V is the depth of the well and L is its length (for a derivation of this expression, see Further reading). We see that the deeper and wider the well, the greater the number of bound states. As the depth becomes infinite, so the number of bound states also becomes infinite, as we have already seen. IMPACT ON NANOSCIENCE I9.1 Scanning probe microscopy Nanoscience is the study of atomic and molecular assemblies with dimensions ranging from 1 nm to about 100 nm and nanotechnology is concerned with the incorporation of such assemblies into devices. The future economic impact of nanotechnology could be very significant. For example, increased demand for very small digital electronic (8mVL)1/2 h Wavefunction x Light particle Heavy particle V Fig. 9.13 The wavefunction of a heavy particle decays more rapidly inside a barrier than that of a light particle. Consequently, a light particle has a greater probability of tunnelling through the barrier. V 0 Lx Fig. 9.14 A potential well with a finite depth. 0 L x n = 1 n = 2 Fig. 9.15 The lowest two bound-state wavefunctions for a particle in the well shown in Fig. 9.14 and one of the wavefunctions corresponding to an unbound state (E > V). I9.1 IMPACT ON NANOSCIENCE: SCANNING PROBE MICROSCOPY 289 devices has driven the design of ever smaller and more powerful microprocessors. However, there is an upper limit on the density of electronic circuits that can be incorporated into silicon-based chips with current fabrication technologies. As the ability to process data increases with the number of circuits in a chip, it follows that soon chips and the devices that use them will have to become bigger if processing power is to increase indefinitely. One way to circumvent this problem is to fabricate devices from nanometre-sized components. We will explore several concepts of nanoscience throughout the text. We begin with the description of scanning probe microscopy (SPM), a collection of techniques that can be used to visualize and manipulate objects as small as atoms on surfaces. Consequently, SPM has far better resolution than electron microscopy (Impact I8.1). One modality of SPM is scanning tunnelling microscopy (STM), in which a platinum– rhodium or tungsten needle is scanned across the surface of a conducting solid. When the tip of the needle is brought very close to the surface, electrons tunnel across the intervening space (Fig. 9.16). In the constant-current mode of operation, the stylus moves up and down corresponding to the form of the surface, and the topography of the surface, including any adsorbates, can be mapped on an atomic scale. The vertical motion of the stylus is achieved by fixing it to a piezoelectric cylinder, which contracts or expands according to the potential difference it experiences. In the constant-z mode, the vertical position of the stylus is held constant and the current is monitored. Because the tunnelling probability is very sensitive to the size of the gap, the microscope can detect tiny, atom-scale variations in the height of the surface. Figure 9.17 shows an example of the kind of image obtained with a surface, in this case of gallium arsenide, that has been modified by addition of atoms, in this case caesium atoms. Each ‘bump’ on the surface corresponds to an atom. In a further variation of the STM technique, the tip may be used to nudge single atoms around on the surface, making possible the fabrication of complex and yet very tiny nanometresized structures. In atomic force microscopy (AFM) a sharpened stylus attached to a cantilever is scanned across the surface. The force exerted by the surface and any bound species pushes or pulls on the stylus and deflects the cantilever (Fig. 9.18). The deflection is monitored either by interferometry or by using a laser beam. Because no current is needed between the sample and the probe, the technique can be applied to nonconducting surfaces too. A spectacular demonstration of the power of AFM is given in Fig. 9.19, which shows individual DNA molecules on a solid surface. Scan Tunnelling current Fig. 9.16 A scanning tunnelling microscope makes use of the current of electrons that tunnel between the surface and the tip. That current is very sensitive to the distance of the tip above the surface. Fig. 9.17 An STM image of caesium atoms on a gallium arsenide surface. Surface Probe Cantilever Laser radiation Probe Fig. 9.18 In atomic force microscopy, a laser beam is used to monitor the tiny changes in the position of a probe as it is attracted to or repelled from atoms on a surface. Fig. 9.19 An AFM image of bacterial DNA plasmids on a mica surface. (Courtesy of Veeco Instruments.) 290 9 QUANTUM THEORY: TECHNIQUES AND APPLICATIONS Example 9.2 Exploring the origin of the current in scanning tunnelling microscopy To get an idea of the distance dependence of the tunnelling current in STM, suppose that the wavefunction of the electron in the gap between sample and needle is given by ψ = Be−κx , where κ = {2me(V − E)/$2 }1/2 ; take V − E = 2.0 eV. By what factor would the current drop if the needle is moved from L1 = 0.50 nm to L2 = 0.60 nm from the surface? Method We regard the tunnelling current to be proportional to the transmission probability T, so the ratio of the currents is equal to the ratio of the transmission probabilities. To choose between eqn 9.20a or 9.20b for the calculation of T, first calculate κL for the shortest distance L1: if κL1 > 1, then use eqn 9.20b. Answer When L = L1 = 0.50 nm and V − E = 2.0 eV = 3.20 × 10−19 J the value of κL is κL1 = 1/2 L1 = 1/2 × (5.0 × 10−10 m) = (7.25 × 109 m−1 ) × (5.0 × 10−10 m) = 3.6 Because κL1 > 1, we use eqn 9.20b to calculate the transmission probabilities at the two distances. It follows that = = = e−2κ(L2−L1) = e−2×(7.25×10−9 m−1)×(1.0×10−10 m) = 0.23 We conclude that, at a distance of 0.60 nm between the surface and the needle, the current is 23 per cent of the value measured when the distance is 0.50 nm. Self-test 9.5 The ability of a proton to tunnel through a barrier contributes to the rapidity of proton transfer reactions in solution and therefore to the properties of acids and bases. Estimate the relative probabilities that a proton and a deuteron can tunnel through the same barrier of height 1.0 eV (1.6 × 10−19 J) and length 100 pm when their energy is 0.9 eV. Any comment? [TH/TD = 3.7 × 102 ; we expect proton transfer reactions to be much faster than deuteron transfer reactions.] Vibrational motion A particle undergoes harmonic motion if it experiences a restoring force proportional to its displacement: F = −kx (9.22) where k is the force constant: the stiffer the ‘spring’, the greater the value of k. Because force is related to potential energy by F = −dV/dx (see Appendix 3), the force in eqn 9.22 corresponds to a potential energy V = 1 –2kx2 (9.23) 16ε(1 − ε)e−2κL2 16ε(1 − ε)e−2κL1 T(L2) T(L1) current at L2 current at L1 5 6 7 2 × (9.109 × 10−31 kg) × (3.20 × 10−19 J) (1.054 × 10−34 J s)2 1 2 3 5 6 7 2me(V − E) $2 1 2 3 9.4 THE ENERGY LEVELS 291 Displacement, x Potentialenergy,V 0 Fig. 9.20 The parabolic potential energy V = 1 –2kx2 of a harmonic oscillator, where x is the displacement from equilibrium. The narrowness of the curve depends on the force constant k: the larger the value of k, the narrower the well. Displacement, x Allowedenergies,Ev 0 v 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 Potential energy, V w Fig. 9.21 The energy levels of a harmonic oscillator are evenly spaced with separation $ω, with ω = (k/m)1/2 . Even in its lowest state, an oscillator has an energy greater than zero. This expression, which is the equation of a parabola (Fig. 9.20), is the origin of the term ‘parabolic potential energy’ for the potential energy characteristic of a harmonic oscillator. The Schrödinger equation for the particle is therefore − + 1 –2kx2 ψ = Eψ (9.24) 9.4 The energy levels Equation 9.24 is a standard equation in the theory of differential equations and its solutions are well known to mathematicians (for details, see Further reading). Quantization of energy levels arises from the boundary conditions: the oscillator will not be found with infinitely large compressions or extensions, so the only allowed solutions are those for which ψ = 0 at x = ±∞. The permitted energy levels are Ev = (v + 1 –2)$ω ω = 1/2 v = 0, 1, 2, . . . (9.25) Note that ω (omega) increases with increasing force constant and decreasing mass. It follows that the separation between adjacent levels is Ev+1 − Ev = $ω (9.26) which is the same for all v. Therefore, the energy levels form a uniform ladder of spacing $ω (Fig. 9.21). The energy separation $ω is negligibly small for macroscopic objects (with large mass), but is of great importance for objects with mass similar to that of atoms. Because the smallest permitted value of v is 0, it follows from eqn 9.26 that a harmonic oscillator has a zero-point energy E0 = 1 –2$ω (9.27) The mathematical reason for the zero-point energy is that v cannot take negative values, for if it did the wavefunction would be ill-behaved. The physical reason is the same as for the particle in a square well: the particle is confined, its position is not completely uncertain, and therefore its momentum, and hence its kinetic energy, cannot be exactly zero. We can picture this zero-point state as one in which the particle fluctuates incessantly around its equilibrium position; classical mechanics would allow the particle to be perfectly still. Illustration 9.3 Calculating a molecular vibrational absorption frequency Atoms vibrate relative to one another in molecules with the bond acting like a spring. Consider an X-H chemical bond, where a heavy X atom forms a stationary anchor for the very light H atom. That is, only the H atom moves, vibrating as a simple harmonic oscillator. Therefore, eqn 9.25 describes the allowed vibrational energy levels of a X-H bond. The force constant of a typical X-H chemical bond is around 500 N m−1 . For example k = 516.3 N m−1 for the 1 H35 Cl bond. Because the mass of a proton is about 1.7 × 10−27 kg, using k = 500 N m−1 in eqn 9.25 gives ω ≈ 5.4 × 1014 s−1 (5.4 × 102 THz). It follows from eqn 9.26 that the separation of adjacent levels is $ω ≈ 5.7 × 10−20 J (57 zJ, about 0.36 eV). This energy separation corresponds to 34 kJ mol−1 , which is chemically significant. From eqn 9.27, the zero-point energy of this molecular oscillator is about 3 zJ, which corresponds to 0.2 eV, or 15 kJ mol−1 . D F k m A C d2 ψ dx2 $2 2m h 292 9 QUANTUM THEORY: TECHNIQUES AND APPLICATIONS -2 -1 0 1 2 x exp()x2 0 1 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 Fig. 9.22 The graph of the Gaussian function, f(x) = e−x2 . Comment 9.2 The Hermite polynomials are solutions of the differential equation HV″ − 2yHV′ + 2VHV = 0 where primes denote differentiation. They satisfy the recursion relation HV+1 − 2yHV + 2VHV−1 = 0 An important integral is Ύ ∞ −∞ HV′HVe−y2 dy = Hermite polynomials are members of a class of functions called orthogonal polynomials. These polynomials have a wide range of important properties that allow a number of quantum mechanical calculations to be done with relative ease. See Further reading for a reference to their properties. 0 if V′ ≠ V π1/2 2V V! if V′ = V 1 2 3 The excitation of the vibration of the bond from one level to the level immediately above requires 57 zJ. Therefore, if it is caused by a photon, the excitation requires radiation of frequency ν = ∆E/h = 86 THz and wavelength λ = c/ν = 3.5 µm. It follows that transitions between adjacent vibrational energy levels of molecules are stimulated by or emit infrared radiation. We shall see in Chapter 13 that the concepts just described represent the starting point for the interpretation of vibrational spectroscopy, an important technique for the characterization of small and large molecules in the gas phase or in condensed phases. 9.5 The wavefunctions It is helpful at the outset to identify the similarities between the harmonic oscillator and the particle in a box, for then we shall be able to anticipate the form of the oscillator wavefunctions without detailed calculation. Like the particle in a box, a particle undergoing harmonic motion is trapped in a symmetrical well in which the potential energy rises to large values (and ultimately to infinity) for sufficiently large displacements (compare Figs. 9.1 and 9.20). However, there are two important differences. First, because the potential energy climbs towards infinity only as x2 and not abruptly, the wavefunction approaches zero more slowly at large displacements than for the particle in a box. Second, as the kinetic energy of the oscillator depends on the displacement in a more complex way (on account of the variation of the potential energy), the curvature of the wavefunction also varies in a more complex way. (a) The form of the wavefunctions The detailed solution of eqn 9.24 shows that the wavefunction for a harmonic oscillator has the form ψ(x) = N × (polynomial in x) × (bell-shaped Gaussian function) where N is a normalization constant. A Gaussian function is a function of the form e−x2 (Fig. 9.22). The precise form of the wavefunctions are ψv(x) = NvHv(y)e−y2/2 y = α = 1/4 (9.28) The factor Hv(y) is a Hermite polynomial (Table 9.1). For instance, because H0(y) = 1, the wavefunction for the ground state (the lowest energy state, with v = 0) of the harmonic oscillator is ψ0(x) = N0e−y2/2 = N0e−x2/2α2 (9.29a) It follows that the probability density is the bell-shaped Gaussian function ψ0 2 (x) = N0 2 e−x2/α2 (9.29b) The wavefunction and the probability distribution are shown in Fig. 9.23. Both curves have their largest values at zero displacement (at x = 0), so they capture the classical picture of the zero-point energy as arising from the ceaseless fluctuation of the particle about its equilibrium position. The wavefunction for the first excited state of the oscillator, the state with v = 1, is obtained by noting that H1(y) = 2y (note that some of the Hermite polynomials are very simple functions!): ψ1(x) = N1 × 2ye−y2/2 (9.30) D F $2 mk A C x α 9.5 THE WAVEFUNCTIONS 293 This function has a node at zero displacement (x = 0), and the probability density has maxima at x = ±α, corresponding to y = ±1 (Fig. 9.24). Once again, we should interpret the mathematical expressions we have derived. In the case of the harmonic oscillator wavefunctions in eqn 9.28, we should note the following: 1. The Gaussian function goes very strongly to zero as the displacement increases (in either direction), so all the wavefunctions approach zero at large displacements. 2. The exponent y2 is proportional to x2 × (mk)1/2 , so the wavefunctions decay more rapidly for large masses and stiff springs. 3. As v increases, the Hermite polynomials become larger at large displacements (as xv ), so the wavefunctions grow large before the Gaussian function damps them down to zero: as a result, the wavefunctions spread over a wider range as v increases. The shapes of several wavefunctions are shown in Fig. 9.25. The shading in Fig. 9.26 that represents the probability density is based on the squares of these functions. At high quantum numbers, harmonic oscillator wavefunctions have their largest amplitudes near the turning points of the classical motion (the locations at which V = E, so Table 9.1 The Hermite polynomials Hv(y) V H1(y) 0 1 1 2y 2 4y2 − 2 3 8y3 − 12y 4 16y4 − 48y2 + 12 5 32y5 − 160y3 + 120y 6 64y6 − 480y4 + 720y2 − 120 -4 -2 0 2 4 y Wavefunction, y 2 y y Fig. 9.23 The normalized wavefunction and probability distribution (shown also by shading) for the lowest energy state of a harmonic oscillator. -4 -2 0 2 4 yWavefunction, y y y 2 Fig. 9.24 The normalized wavefunction and probability distribution (shown also by shading) for the first excited state of a harmonic oscillator. 1.0 0.5 0 -0.5 -1.0 -4 -2 0 2 4 y 0 3 Wavefunction, 4 1 2 y Fig. 9.25 The normalized wavefunctions for the first five states of a harmonic oscillator. Note that the number of nodes is equal to v and that alternate wavefunctions are symmetrical or antisymmetrical about y = 0 (zero displacement). 0 1 2 3 4 20 Fig. 9.26 The probability distributions for the first five states of a harmonic oscillator and the state with v = 20. Note how the regions of highest probability move towards the turning points of the classical motion as v increases. Exploration To gain some insight into the origins of the nodes in the harmonic oscillator wavefunctions, plot the Hermite polynomials Hv(y) for v = 0 through 5. 294 9 QUANTUM THEORY: TECHNIQUES AND APPLICATIONS the kinetic energy is zero). We see classical properties emerging in the correspondence limit of high quantum numbers, for a classical particle is most likely to be found at the turning points (where it travels most slowly) and is least likely to be found at zero displacement (where it travels most rapidly). Example 9.3 Normalizing a harmonic oscillator wavefunction Find the normalization constant for the harmonic oscillator wavefunctions. Method Normalization is always carried out by evaluating the integral of |ψ|2 over all space and then finding the normalization factor from eqn 8.16. The normalized wavefunction is then equal to Nψ. In this one-dimensional problem, the volume element is dx and the integration is from −∞ to +∞. The wavefunctions are expressed in terms of the dimensionless variable y = x/α, so begin by expressing the integral in terms of y by using dx = αdy. The integrals required are given in Comment 9.2. Answer The unnormalized wavefunction is ψv(x) = Hv(y)e−y2/2 It follows from the integrals given in Comment 9.2 that Ύ ∞ −∞ ψv*ψvdx = αΎ ∞ −∞ ψv*ψvdy = αΎ ∞ −∞ Hv 2 (y)e−y2 dy = απ1/2 2v v! where v! = v(v − 1)(v − 2) . . . 1. Therefore, Nv = 1/2 Note that for a harmonic oscillator Nv is different for each value of v. Self-test 9.6 Confirm, by explicit evaluation of the integral, that ψ0 and ψ1 are orthogonal. [Evaluate the integral ∫ ∞ −∞ψ0*ψ1 dx by using the information in Comment 9.2.] (b) The properties of oscillators With the wavefunctions that are available, we can start calculating the properties of a harmonic oscillator. For instance, we can calculate the expectation values of an observable Ω by evaluating integrals of the type ͗Ω͘ = Ύ ∞ −∞ ψv*)ψvdx (9.31) (Here and henceforth, the wavefunctions are all taken to be normalized to 1.) When the explicit wavefunctions are substituted, the integrals look fearsome, but the Hermite polynomials have many simplifying features. For instance, we show in the following example that the mean displacement, ͗x͘, and the mean square displacement, ͗x2 ͘, of the oscillator when it is in the state with quantum number v are ͗x͘ = 0 ͗x2 ͘ = (v + 1 –2) (9.32) $ (mk)1/2 D F 1 απ1/2 2v v! A C 9.5 THE WAVEFUNCTIONS 295 Comment 9.3 An even function is one for which f(−x) = f(x); an odd function is one for which f(−x) = −f(x). The product of an odd and even function is itself odd, and the integral of an odd function over a symmetrical range about x = 0 is zero. The result for ͗x͘ shows that the oscillator is equally likely to be found on either side of x = 0 (like a classical oscillator). The result for ͗x2 ͘ shows that the mean square displacement increases with v. This increase is apparent from the probability densities in Fig. 9.26, and corresponds to the classical amplitude of swing increasing as the oscillator becomes more highly excited. Example 9.4 Calculating properties of a harmonic oscillator We can imagine the bending motion of a CO2 molecule as a harmonic oscillation relative to the linear conformation of the molecule. We may be interested in the extent to which the molecule bends. Calculate the mean displacement of the oscillator when it is in a quantum state v. Method Normalized wavefunctions must be used to calculate the expectation value. The operator for position along x is multiplication by the value of x (Section 8.5b). The resulting integral can be evaluated either by inspection (the integrand is the product of an odd and an even function), or by explicit evaluation using the formulas in Comment 9.2. To give practice in this type of calculation, we illustrate the latter procedure. We shall need the relation x = αy, which implies that dx = αdy. Answer The integral we require is ͗x͘ = Ύ ∞ −∞ ψv*xψvdx = Nv 2 Ύ ∞ −∞ (Hve−y2/2 )x(Hve−y2/2 )dx = α2 Nv 2 Ύ ∞ −∞ (Hve−y2/2 )y(Hve−y2/2 )dy = α2 Nv 2 Ύ ∞ −∞ HvyHve−y2 dy Now use the recursion relation (see Comment 9.2) to form yHv = vHv−1 + 1 –2Hv+1 which turns the integral into Ύ ∞ −∞ HvyHve−y2 dy = vΎ ∞ −∞ Hv−1Hve−y2 dy + 1 –2 Ύ ∞ −∞ Hv+1Hve−y2 dy Both integrals are zero, so ͗x͘ = 0. As remarked in the text, the mean displacement is zero because the displacement occurs equally on either side of the equilibrium position. The following Self-test extends this calculation by examining the mean square displacement, which we can expect to be non-zero and to increase with increasing v. Self-test 9.7 Calculate the mean square displacement ͗x2 ͘ of the particle from its equilibrium position. (Use the recursion relation twice.) [eqn 9.32] The mean potential energy of an oscillator, the expectation value of V = 1 –2kx2 , can now be calculated very easily: ͗V͘ = ͗1 –2kx2 ͘ = 1 –2(v + 1 –2)$ 1/2 = 1 –2(v + 1 –2)$ω (9.33) D F k m A C 296 9 QUANTUM THEORY: TECHNIQUES AND APPLICATIONS Because the total energy in the state with quantum number v is (v + 1 –2)$ω, it follows that ͗V͘ = 1 –2Ev (9.34a) The total energy is the sum of the potential and kinetic energies, so it follows at once that the mean kinetic energy of the oscillator is ͗EK͘ = 1 –2Ev (9.34b) The result that the mean potential and kinetic energies of a harmonic oscillator are equal (and therefore that both are equal to half the total energy) is a special case of the virial theorem: If the potential energy of a particle has the form V = axb , then its mean potential and kinetic energies are related by 2͗EK͘ = b͗V͘ (9.35) For a harmonic oscillator b = 2, so ͗EK͘ = ͗V͘, as we have found. The virial theorem is a short cut to the establishment of a number of useful results, and we shall use it again. An oscillator may be found at extensions with V > E that are forbidden by classical physics, for they correspond to negative kinetic energy. For example, it follows from the shape of the wavefunction (see the Justification below) that in its lowest energy state there is about an 8 per cent chance of finding an oscillator stretched beyond its classical limit and an 8 per cent chance of finding it with a classically forbidden compression. These tunnelling probabilities are independent of the force constant and mass of the oscillator. The probability of being found in classically forbidden regions decreases quickly with increasing v, and vanishes entirely as v approaches infinity, as we would expect from the correspondence principle. Macroscopic oscillators (such as pendulums) are in states with very high quantum numbers, so the probability that they will be found in a classically forbidden region is wholly negligible. Molecules, however, are normally in their vibrational ground states, and for them the probability is very significant. Justification 9.4 Tunnelling in the quantum mechanical harmonic oscillator According to classical mechanics, the turning point, xtp, of an oscillator occurs when its kinetic energy is zero, which is when its potential energy 1 –2kx2 is equal to its total energy E. This equality occurs when x2 tp = or, xtp = ± 1/2 with E given by eqn 9.25. The probability of finding the oscillator stretched beyond a displacement xtp is the sum of the probabilities ψ2 dx of finding it in any of the intervals dx lying between xtp and infinity: P = Ύ ∞ xtp ψv 2 dx The variable of integration is best expressed in terms of y = x/α with α = ($2 /mk)1/2 , and then the turning point on the right lies at ytp = = 1/2 = (2v + 1)1/2 For the state of lowest energy (v = 0), ytp = 1 and the probability is 5 6 7 2(v + 1 –2)$ω α2 k 1 2 3 xtp α D E F 2E k A B C 2E k 9.6 ROTATION IN TWO DIMENSIONS: A PARTICLE ON A RING 297 P = Ύ ∞ xtp ψ0 2 dx = αN0 2 Ύ1 ∞ e−y2 dy The integral is a special case of the error function, erf z, which is defined as follows: erf z = 1 − Ύ ∞ z e−y2 dy The values of this function are tabulated and available in mathematical software packages, and a small selection of values is given in Table 9.2. In the present case P = 1 –2(1 − erf 1) = 1 –2(1 − 0.843) = 0.079 It follows that, in 7.9 per cent of a large number of observations, any oscillator in the state v = 0 will be found stretched to a classically forbidden extent. There is the same probability of finding the oscillator with a classically forbidden compression. The total probability of finding the oscillator tunnelled into a classically forbidden region (stretched or compressed) is about 16 per cent. A similar calculation for the state with v = 6 shows that the probability of finding the oscillator outside the classical turning points has fallen to about 7 per cent. Rotational motion The treatment of rotational motion can be broken down into two parts. The first deals with motion in two dimensions and the second with rotation in three dimensions. It may be helpful to review the classical description of rotational motion given in Appendix 3, particularly the concepts of moment of inertia and angular momentum. 9.6 Rotation in two dimensions: a particle on a ring We consider a particle of mass m constrained to move in a circular path of radius r in the xy-plane (Fig. 9.27). The total energy is equal to the kinetic energy, because V = 0 everywhere. We can therefore write E = p2 /2m. According to classical mechanics, the angular momentum, Jz, around the z-axis (which lies perpendicular to the xy-plane) is Jz = ±pr, so the energy can be expressed as Jz 2 /2mr2 . Because mr2 is the moment of inertia, I, of the mass on its path, it follows that E = (9.36) We shall now see that not all the values of the angular momentum are permitted in quantum mechanics, and therefore that both angular momentum and rotational energy are quantized. (a) The qualitative origin of quantized rotation Because Jz = ±pr, and, from the de Broglie relation, p = h/λ, the angular momentum about the z-axis is Jz = ± Opposite signs correspond to opposite directions of travel. This equation shows that the shorter the wavelength of the particle on a circular path of given radius, the greater the angular momentum of the particle. It follows that, if we can see why the hr λ Jz 2 2I 2 π1/2 r m x y z p Jz Fig. 9.27 The angular momentum of a particle of mass m on a circular path of radius r in the xy-plane is represented by a vector J with the single non-zero component Jz of magnitude pr perpendicular to the plane. Table 9.2 The error function z erf z 0 0 0.01 0.0113 0.05 0.0564 0.10 0.1125 0.50 0.5205 1.00 0.8427 1.50 0.9661 2.00 0.9953 298 9 QUANTUM THEORY: TECHNIQUES AND APPLICATIONS wavelength is restricted to discrete values, then we shall understand why the angular momentum is quantized. Suppose for the moment that λ can take an arbitrary value. In that case, the wavefunction depends on the azimuthal angle φ as shown in Fig. 9.28a. When φ increases beyond 2π, the wavefunction continues to change, but for an arbitrary wavelength it gives rise to a different value at each point, which is unacceptable (Section 8.4b). An acceptable solution is obtained only if the wavefunction reproduces itself on successive circuits, as in Fig. 9.28b. Because only some wavefunctions have this property, it follows that only some angular momenta are acceptable, and therefore that only certain rotational energies exist. Hence, the energy of the particle is quantized. Specifically, the only allowed wavelengths are λ = with ml, the conventional notation for this quantum number, taking integral values including 0. The value ml = 0 corresponds to λ = ∞; a ‘wave’ of infinite wavelength has a constant height at all values of φ. The angular momentum is therefore limited to the values Jz = ± = = where we have allowed ml to have positive or negative values. That is, Jz = ml$ ml = 0, ±1, ±2, . . . (9.37) Positive values of ml correspond to rotation in a clockwise sense around the z-axis (as viewed in the direction of z, Fig. 9.29) and negative values of ml correspond to counter-clockwise rotation around z. It then follows from eqn 9.36 that the energy is limited to the values E = = (9.38a) We shall see shortly that the corresponding normalized wavefunctions are ψml (φ) = (9.38b) The wavefunction with ml = 0 is ψ0(φ) = 1/(2π)1/2 , and has the same value at all points on the circle. We have arrived at a number of conclusions about rotational motion by combining some classical notions with the de Broglie relation. Such a procedure can be very useful for establishing the general form (and, as in this case, the exact energies) for a quantum mechanical system. However, to be sure that the correct solutions have been obtained, and to obtain practice for more complex problems where this less formal approach is inadequate, we need to solve the Schrödinger equation explicitly. The formal solution is described in the Justification that follows. Justification 9.5 The energies and wavefunctions of a particle on a ring The hamiltonian for a particle of mass m in a plane (with V = 0) is the same as that given in eqn 9.10: @ = − + D E F ∂2 ∂y2 ∂2 ∂x2 A B C $2 2m eimlφ (2π)1/2 ml 2 $2 2I Jz 2 2I mlh 2π mlhr 2πr hr λ 2πr ml Second circuit Second circuit First circuit First circuit p p 2p 2p 0 0 (a) (b) f f Wavefunction,Wavefunction,yy ml 0> ml 0< (a) (b) Fig. 9.28 Two solutions of the Schrödinger equation for a particle on a ring. The circumference has been opened out into a straight line; the points at φ = 0 and 2π are identical. The solution in (a) is unacceptable because it is not singlevalued. Moreover, on successive circuits it interferes destructively with itself, and does not survive. The solution in (b) is acceptable: it is single-valued, and on successive circuits it reproduces itself. Fig. 9.29 The angular momentum of a particle confined to a plane can be represented by a vector of length |ml | units along the z-axis and with an orientation that indicates the direction of motion of the particle. The direction is given by the right-hand screw rule. 9.6 ROTATION IN TWO DIMENSIONS: A PARTICLE ON A RING 299 and the Schrödinger equation is Hψ = Eψ, with the wavefunction a function of the angle φ. It is always a good idea to use coordinates that reflect the full symmetry of the system, so we introduce the coordinates r and φ (Fig. 9.30), where x = r cos φ and y = r sin φ. By standard manipulations (see Further reading) we can write + = + + (9.39) However, because the radius of the path is fixed, the derivatives with respect to r can be discarded. The hamiltonian then becomes @ = − The moment of inertia I = mr2 has appeared automatically, so H may be written @ = − (9.40) and the Schrödinger equation is = − ψ (9.41) The normalized general solutions of the equation are ψml (φ) = ml = ± (9.42) The quantity ml is just a dimensionless number at this stage. We now select the acceptable solutions from among these general solutions by imposing the condition that the wavefunction should be single-valued. That is, the wavefunction ψ must satisfy a cyclic boundary condition, and match at points separated by a complete revolution: ψ(φ + 2π) = ψ(φ). On substituting the general wavefunction into this condition, we find ψml (φ + 2π) = = = ψml (φ)e2πiml As eiπ = −1, this relation is equivalent to ψml (φ + 2π) = (−1)2mlψ(φ) (9.43) Because we require (−1)2ml = 1, 2ml must be a positive or a negative even integer (including 0), and therefore ml must be an integer: ml = 0, ±1, ±2, . . . . (b) Quantization of rotation We can summarize the conclusions so far as follows. The energy is quantized and restricted to the values given in eqn 9.38a (E = ml 2 $2 /2I). The occurrence of ml as its square means that the energy of rotation is independent of the sense of rotation (the sign of ml), as we expect physically. In other words, states with a given value of |ml | are doubly degenerate, except for ml = 0, which is non-degenerate. Although the result has been derived for the rotation of a single mass point, it also applies to any body of moment of inertia I constrained to rotate about one axis. We have also seen that the angular momentum is quantized and confined to the values given in eqn 9.37 (Jz = ml$). The increasing angular momentum is associated with the increasing number of nodes in the real and imaginary parts of the wavefunction: the wavelength decreases stepwise as |ml | increases, so the momentum with which the particle travels round the ring increases (Fig. 9.31). As shown in the following eimlφ e2πiml (2π)1/2 eiml(φ+2π) (2π)1/2 (2IE)1/2 $ eimlφ (2π)1/2 2IE $2 d2 ψ dφ2 d2 dφ2 $2 2I d2 dφ2 $2 2mr2 ∂2 ∂φ2 1 r2 ∂ ∂r 1 r ∂2 ∂r2 ∂2 ∂y2 ∂2 ∂x2 x yf r z Fig. 9.30 The cylindrical coordinates z, r, and φ for discussing systems with axial (cylindrical) symmetry. For a particle confined to the xy-plane, only r and φ can change. ml = 0 | | = 1ml | | = 2ml Fig. 9.31 The real parts of the wavefunctions of a particle on a ring. As shorter wavelengths are achieved, the magnitude of the angular momentum around the z-axis grows in steps of $. Comment 9.4 The complex function eimlφ does not have nodes; however, it may be written as cos mlφ + i sin mlφ, and the real (cos mlφ) and imaginary (sin mlφ) components do have nodes. 300 9 QUANTUM THEORY: TECHNIQUES AND APPLICATIONS Justification, we can come to the same conclusion more formally by using the argument about the relation between eigenvalues and the values of observables established in Section 8.5. Justification 9.6 The quantization of angular momentum In the discussion of translational motion in one dimension, we saw that the opposite signs in the wavefunctions eikx and e−ikx correspond to opposite directions of travel, and that the linear momentum is given by the eigenvalue of the linear momentum operator. The same conclusions can be drawn here, but now we need the eigenvalues of the angular momentum operator. In classical mechanics the orbital angular momentum lz about the z-axis is defined as lz = xpy − ypx [9.44] where px is the component of linear motion parallel to the x-axis and py is the component parallel to the y-axis. The operators for the two linear momentum components are given in eqn 8.26, so the operator for angular momentum about the z-axis, which we denote Zz, is Zz = x − y (9.45) When expressed in terms of the coordinates r and φ, by standard manipulations this equation becomes Zz = (9.46) With the angular momentum operator available, we can test the wavefunction in eqn 9.38b. Disregarding the normalization constant, we find Zzψml = = iml eimlφ = ml$ψml (9.47) That is, ψml is an eigenfunction of Zz, and corresponds to an angular momentum ml$. When ml is positive, the angular momentum is positive (clockwise when seen from below); when ml is negative, the angular momentum is negative (counterclockwise when seen from below). These features are the origin of the vector representation of angular momentum, in which the magnitude is represented by the length of a vector and the direction of motion by its orientation (Fig. 9.32). To locate the particle given its wavefunction in eqn 9.38b, we form the probability density: ψ*ml ψml = * = = Because this probability density is independent of φ, the probability of locating the particle somewhere on the ring is also independent of φ (Fig. 9.33). Hence the location of the particle is completely indefinite, and knowing the angular momentum precisely eliminates the possibility of specifying the particle’s location. Angular momentum and angle are a pair of complementary observables (in the sense defined in Section 8.6), and the inability to specify them simultaneously with arbitrary precision is another example of the uncertainty principle. 1 2π D F eimlφ (2π)1/2 A C D F e−imlφ (2π)1/2 A C D F eimlφ (2π)1/2 A C D F eimlφ (2π)1/2 A C $ i dψml dφ $ i ∂ ∂φ $ i D E F ∂ ∂x ∂ ∂y A B C $ i Comment 9.5 The angular momentum in three dimensions is defined as l = r × p = = (ypz − zpy)i − (xpz − zpx)j + (xpy − ypx)k where i, j, and k are unit vectors pointing along the positive directions on the x-, y-, and z-axes. It follows that the z-component of the angular momentum has a magnitude given by eqn 9.44. For more information on vectors, see Appendix 2. i i i i j k x y z px py pz i i i Angular momentum Fig. 9.32 The basic ideas of the vector representation of angular momentum: the magnitude of the angular momentum is represented by the length of the vector, and the orientation of the motion in space by the orientation of the vector (using the right-hand screw rule). 9.7 ROTATION IN THREE DIMENSIONS: THE PARTICLE ON A SPHERE 301 9.7 Rotation in three dimensions: the particle on a sphere We now consider a particle of mass m that is free to move anywhere on the surface of a sphere of radius r. We shall need the results of this calculation when we come to describe rotating molecules and the states of electrons in atoms and in small clusters of atoms. The requirement that the wavefunction should match as a path is traced over the poles as well as round the equator of the sphere surrounding the central point introduces a second cyclic boundary condition and therefore a second quantum number (Fig. 9.34). (a) The Schrödinger equation The hamiltonian for motion in three dimensions (Table 8.1) is @ = − ∇2 + V ∇2 = + + (9.48) The symbol ∇2 is a convenient abbreviation for the sum of the three second derivatives; it is called the laplacian, and read either ‘del squared’ or ‘nabla squared’. For the particle confined to a spherical surface, V = 0 wherever it is free to travel, and the radius r is a constant. The wavefunction is therefore a function of the colatitude, θ, and the azimuth, φ (Fig. 9.35), and we write it ψ(θ,φ). The Schrödinger equation is − ∇2 ψ = Eψ (9.49) As shown in the following Justification, this partial differential equation can be simplified by the separation of variables procedure by expressing the wavefunction (for constant r) as the product ψ(θ,φ) = Θ(θ)Φ(φ) (9.50) where Θ is a function only of θ and Φ is a function only of φ. Justification 9.7 The separation of variables technique applied to the particle on a sphere The laplacian in spherical polar coordinates is (see Further reading) ∇2 = + + Λ2 (9.51a) where the legendrian, Λ2 , is Λ2 = + sin θ (9.51b) Because r is constant, we can discard the part of the laplacian that involves differentiation with respect to r, and so write the Schrödinger equation as Λ2 ψ = − ψ or, because I = mr2 , as Λ2 ψ = −εψ ε = 2IE $2 2mE $2 1 r2 ∂ ∂θ ∂ ∂θ 1 sin θ ∂2 ∂φ2 1 sin2 θ 1 r2 ∂ ∂r 2 r ∂2 ∂r2 $2 2m ∂2 ∂z2 ∂2 ∂y2 ∂2 ∂x2 $2 2m Re Im f * 0 2 f 2 0 y y y y p p q f Fig. 9.33 The probability density for a particle in a definite state of angular momentum is uniform, so there is an equal probability of finding the particle anywhere on the ring. Fig. 9.34 The wavefunction of a particle on the surface of a sphere must satisfy two cyclic boundary conditions; this requirement leads to two quantum numbers for its state of angular momentum. z x y r q f Fig. 9.35 Spherical polar coordinates. For a particle confined to the surface of a sphere, only the colatitude, θ, and the azimuth, φ, can change. 302 9 QUANTUM THEORY: TECHNIQUES AND APPLICATIONS To verify that this expression is separable, we substitute ψ = ΘΦ: + sin θ = −εΘΦ We now use the fact that Θ and Φ are each functions of one variable, so the partial derivatives become complete derivatives: + sin θ = −εΘΦ Division through by ΘΦ, multiplication by sin2 θ, and minor rearrangement gives Φ + sin θ + ε sin2 θ = 0 The first term on the left depends only on φ and the remaining two terms depend only on θ. We met a similar situation when discussing a particle on a rectangular surface (Justification 9.3), and by the same argument, the complete equation can be separated. Thus, if we set the first term equal to the numerical constant −ml 2 (using a notation chosen with an eye to the future), the separated equations are = −ml 2 sin θ + ε sin2 θ = ml 2 The first of these two equations is the same as that in Justification 9.5, so it has the same solutions (eqn 9.38b). The second is much more complicated to solve, but the solutions are tabulated as the associated Legendre functions. The cyclic boundary conditions on Θ result in the introduction of a second quantum number, l, which identifies the acceptable solutions. The presence of the quantum number ml in the second equation implies, as we see below, that the range of acceptable values of ml is restricted by the value of l. As indicated in Justification 9.7, solution of the Schrödinger equation shows that the acceptable wavefunctions are specified by two quantum numbers l and ml that are restricted to the values l = 0, 1, 2, . . . ml = l, l − 1, . . . , −l (9.52) Note that the orbital angular momentum quantum number l is non-negative and that, for a given value of l, there are 2l + 1 permitted values of the magnetic quantum number, ml. The normalized wavefunctions are usually denoted Yl,ml (θ,φ) and are called the spherical harmonics (Table 9.3). Figure 9.36 is a representation of the spherical harmonics for l = 0 to 4 and ml = 0 which emphasizes how the number of angular nodes (the positions at which the wavefunction passes through zero) increases as the value of l increases. There are no angular nodes around the z-axis for functions with ml = 0, which corresponds to there being no component of orbital angular momentum about that axis. Figure 9.37 shows the distribution of the particle of a given angular momentum in more detail. In this representation, the value of |Yl,ml |2 at each value of θ and φ is proportional to the distance of the surface from the origin. Note how, for a given value of l, the most probable location of the particle migrates towards the xy-plane as the value of |ml | increases. It also follows from the solution of the Schrödinger equation that the energy E of the particle is restricted to the values E = l(l + 1) l = 0, 1, 2, . . . (9.53) $2 2I dΘ dθ d dθ sin θ Θ d2 Φ dφ2 1 Φ dΘ dθ d dθ sin θ Θ d2 Φ dφ2 dΘ dθ d dθ Φ sin θ d2 Φ dφ2 Θ sin2 θ ∂(ΦΘ) ∂θ ∂ ∂θ 1 sin θ ∂2 (ΘΦ) ∂φ2 1 sin2 θ Table 9.3 The spherical harmonics l ml Yl,ml (θ,ϕ) 0 0 1/2 1 0 1/2 cos θ ±1 , 1/2 sin θ e±iφ 2 0 1/2 (3 cos2 θ − 1) ±1 , 1/2 cos θ sin θ e±iφ ±2 1/2 sin2 θ e±2iφ 3 0 1/2 (5 cos3 θ − 3 cos θ) ±1 , 1/2 (5 cos2 θ − 1)sin θ e±iφ ±2 1/2 sin2 θ cos θ e±2iφ ±3 , 1/2 sin3 θ e±3iφ D E F 35 64π A B C D E F 105 32π A B C D E F 21 64π A B C D E F 7 16π A B C D E F 15 32π A B C D E F 15 8π A B C D E F 5 16π A B C D E F 3 8π A B C D E F 3 4π A B C D E F 1 4π A B C Comment 9.6 The spherical harmonics are orthogonal and normalized in the following sense: Ύ0 π Ύ0 2π Yl′,ml′(θ,φ)*Yl,ml (θ,φ) sin θ dθ dφ = δl′lδml′ml An important ‘triple integral’ is Ύ0 π Ύ0 2π Yl′,ml″(θ,φ)*Yl′,ml′(θ,φ)Yl,ml (θ,φ) sin θ dθ dφ = 0 unless ml″ = ml′ + ml and we can form a triangle with sides of lengths l″, l′, and l (such as 1, 2, and 3 or 1, 1, and 1, but not 1, 2, and 4). Comment 9.7 The real and imaginary components of the Φ component of the wavefunctions, eimlφ = cos mlφ + i sin mlφ, each have |ml | angular nodes, but these nodes are not seen when we plot the probability density, because |eimlφ |2 = 1. 9.7 ROTATION IN THREE DIMENSIONS: THE PARTICLE ON A SPHERE 303 l = 0 l = 1 l = 2 l = 3 1 2 3| | =ml 0 Fig. 9.37 A more complete representation of the wavefunctions for l = 0, 1, 2, and 3. The distance of a point on the surface from the origin is proportional to the square modulus of the amplitude of the wavefunction at that point. Exploration Plot the variation with the radius r of the first ten energy levels of a particle on a sphere. Which of the following statements are true: (a) for a given value of r, the energy separation between adjacent levels decreases with increasing l, (b) increasing r leads to an decrease in the value of the energy for each level, (c) the energy difference between adjacent levels increases as r increases. l m= 0, = 0l l m= 4, = 0l l m= 3, = 0l l m= 2, = 0l l m= 1, = 0l l m= 3, = 0l Fig. 9.36 A representation of the wavefunctions of a particle on the surface of a sphere which emphasizes the location of angular nodes: dark and light shading correspond to different signs of the wavefunction. Note that the number of nodes increases as the value of l increases. All these wavefunctions correspond to ml = 0; a path round the vertical z-axis of the sphere does not cut through any nodes. 304 9 QUANTUM THEORY: TECHNIQUES AND APPLICATIONS We see that the energy is quantized, and that it is independent of ml. Because there are 2l + 1 different wavefunctions (one for each value of ml) that correspond to the same energy, it follows that a level with quantum number l is (2l + 1)-fold degenerate. (b) Angular momentum The energy of a rotating particle is related classically to its angular momentum J by E = J2 /2I (see Appendix 3). Therefore, by comparing this equation with eqn 9.53, we can deduce that, because the energy is quantized, then so too is the magnitude of the angular momentum, and confined to the values Magnitude of angular momentum = {l(l + 1)}1/2 $ l = 0, 1, 2 . . . (9.54a) We have already seen (in the context of rotation in a plane) that the angular momentum about the z-axis is quantized, and that it has the values z-Component of angular momentum = ml$ ml = l, l − 1, . . . , −l (9.54b) The fact that the number of nodes in ψl,ml (θ,φ) increases with l reflects the fact that higher angular momentum implies higher kinetic energy, and therefore a more sharply buckled wavefunction. We can also see that the states corresponding to high angular momentum around the z-axis are those in which most nodal lines cut the equator: a high kinetic energy now arises from motion parallel to the equator because the curvature is greatest in that direction. Illustration 9.4 Calculating the frequency of a molecular rotational transition Under certain circumstances, the particle on a sphere is a reasonable model for the description of the rotation of diatomic molecules. Consider, for example, the rotation of a 1 H127 I molecule: because of the large difference in atomic masses, it is appropriate to picture the 1 H atom as orbiting a stationary 127 I atom at a distance r = 160 pm, the equilibrium bond distance. The moment of inertia of 1 H127 I is then I = mHr2 = 4.288 × 10−47 kg m2 . It follows that = = 1.297 × 10−22 J or 0.1297 zJ. This energy corresponds to 78.09 J mol−1 . From eqn 9.53, the first few rotational energy levels are therefore 0 (l = 0), 0.2594 zJ (l = 1), 0.7782 zJ (l = 2), and 1.556 zJ (l = 3). The degeneracies of these levels are 1, 3, 5, and 7, respectively (from 2l + 1), and the magnitudes of the angular momentum of the molecule are 0, 21/2 $, 61/2 $, and (12)1/2 $ (from eqn 9.54a). It follows from our calculations that the l = 0 and l = 1 levels are separated by ∆E = 0.2594 zJ. A transition between these two rotational levels of the molecule can be brought about by the emission or absorption of a photon with a frequency given by the Bohr frequency condition (eqn 8.10): ν = = = 3.915 × 1011 Hz = 391.5 GHz Radiation with this frequency belongs to the microwave region of the electromagnetic spectrum, so microwave spectroscopy is a convenient method for the study of molecular rotations. Because the transition energies depend on the moment of inertia, microwave spectroscopy is a very accurate technique for the determination of bond lengths. We discuss rotational spectra further in Chapter 13. 2.594 × 10−22 J 6.626 × 10−34 J s ∆E h (1.054 57 × 10−34 J s)2 2 × (4.288 × 10−47 kg m2 ) $2 2I 9.7 ROTATION IN THREE DIMENSIONS: THE PARTICLE ON A SPHERE 305 Self-test 9.8 Repeat the calculation for a 2 H127 I molecule (same bond length as 1 H127 I). [Energies are smaller by a factor of two; same angular momenta and numbers of components] ml 1= + ml 0= ml 1= ml 2= ml 2= + z Fig. 9.38 The permitted orientations of angular momentum when l = 2. We shall see soon that this representation is too specific because the azimuthal orientation of the vector (its angle around z) is indeterminate. (a) (b) (c) Fig. 9.39 (a) The experimental arrangement for the Stern–Gerlach experiment: the magnet provides an inhomogeneous field. (b) The classically expected result. (c) The observed outcome using silver atoms. (c) Space quantization The result that ml is confined to the values l, l − 1, . . . , −l for a given value of l means that the component of angular momentum about the z-axis may take only 2l + 1 values. If the angular momentum is represented by a vector of length proportional to its magnitude (that is, of length {l(l + 1)}1/2 units), then to represent correctly the value of the component of angular momentum, the vector must be oriented so that its projection on the z-axis is of length ml units. In classical terms, this restriction means that the plane of rotation of the particle can take only a discrete range of orientations (Fig. 9.38). The remarkable implication is that the orientation of a rotating body is quantized. The quantum mechanical result that a rotating body may not take up an arbitrary orientation with respect to some specified axis (for example, an axis defined by the direction of an externally applied electric or magnetic field) is called space quantization. It was confirmed by an experiment first performed by Otto Stern and Walther Gerlach in 1921, who shot a beam of silver atoms through an inhomogeneous magnetic field (Fig. 9.39). The idea behind the experiment was that a rotating, charged body behaves like a magnet and interacts with the applied field. According to classical mechanics, because the orientation of the angular momentum can take any value, the associated magnet can take any orientation. Because the direction in which the magnet is driven by the inhomogeneous field depends on the magnet’s orientation, it follows that a broad band of atoms is expected to emerge from the region where the magnetic field acts. According to quantum mechanics, however, because the angular momentum is quantized, the associated magnet lies in a number of discrete orientations, so several sharp bands of atoms are expected. In their first experiment, Stern and Gerlach appeared to confirm the classical prediction. However, the experiment is difficult because collisions between the atoms in the beam blur the bands. When the experiment was repeated with a beam of very low intensity (so that collisions were less frequent) they observed discrete bands, and so confirmed the quantum prediction. (d) The vector model Throughout the preceding discussion, we have referred to the z-component of angular momentum (the component about an arbitrary axis, which is conventionally denoted z), and have made no reference to the x- and y-components (the components 306 9 QUANTUM THEORY: TECHNIQUES AND APPLICATIONS about the two axes perpendicular to z). The reason for this omission is found by examining the operators for the three components, each one being given by a term like that in eqn 9.45: Zx = y − z Zy = z − x Zz = x − y (9.55) As you are invited to show in Problem 9.27, these three operators do not commute with one another: [Zx,Zy] = i$Zz [Zy,Zz] = i$Zx [Zz,Zx] = i$Zy (9.56a) Therefore, we cannot specify more than one component (unless l = 0). In other words, lx, ly, and lz are complementary observables. On the other hand, the operator for the square of the magnitude of the angular momentum is Z2 = Z2 x + Z2 y + Z2 z = $2 Λ2 (9.56b) where Λ2 is the legendrian in eqn 9.51b. This operator does commute with all three components: [Z2 ,Zq] = 0 q = x, y, and z (9.56c) (See Problem 9.29.) Therefore, although we may specify the magnitude of the angular momentum and any of its components, if lz is known, then it is impossible to ascribe values to the other two components. It follows that the illustration in Fig. 9.38, which is summarized in Fig. 9.40a, gives a false impression of the state of the system, because it suggests definite values for the x- and y-components. A better picture must reflect the impossibility of specifying lx and ly if lz is known. The vector model of angular momentum uses pictures like that in Fig. 9.40b. The cones are drawn with side {l(l + 1)}1/2 units, and represent the magnitude of the angular momentum. Each cone has a definite projection (of ml units) on the z-axis, representing the system’s precise value of lz. The lx and ly projections, however, are indefinite. The vector representing the state of angular momentum can be thought of as lying with its tip on any point on the mouth of the cone. At this stage it should not be thought of as sweeping round the cone; that aspect of the model will be added later when we allow the picture to convey more information. IMPACT ON NANOSCIENCE I9.2 Quantum dots In Impact I9.1 we outlined some advantages of working in the nanometre regime. Another is the possibility of using quantum mechanical effects that render the properties of an assembly dependent on its size. Here we focus on the origins and consequences of these quantum mechanical effects. Consider a sample of a metal, such as copper or gold. It carries an electrical current because the electrons are delocalized over all the atomic nuclei. That is, we may treat the movement of electrons in metals with a particle in a box model, though it is necessary to imagine that the electrons move independently of each other. Immediately, we predict from eqn 9.6 that the energy levels of the electrons in a large box, such as a copper wire commonly used to make electrical connections, form a continuum so we are justified in neglecting quantum mechanical effects on the properties of the material. However, consider a nanocrystal, a small cluster of atoms with dimensions in the nanometre scale. Again using eqn 9.6, we predict that the electronic energies are quantized and that the separation between energy levels decreases with increasing size of the cluster. This quantum mechanical effect can be observed in ‘boxes’ of any D F ∂ ∂x ∂ ∂y A C $ i D F ∂ ∂z ∂ ∂x A C $ i D F ∂ ∂y ∂ ∂z A C $ i +2 +1 0 -1 -2 z ml (a) -1 -2 z +2 +1 0 (b) Fig. 9.40 (a) A summary of Fig. 9.38. However, because the azimuthal angle of the vector around the z-axis is indeterminate, a better representation is as in (b), where each vector lies at an unspecified azimuthal angle on its cone. I9.2 IMPACT ON NANOSCIENCE: QUANTUM DOTS 307 shape. For example, you are invited to show in Problem 9.39 that the energy levels of an electron in a sphere of radius R are given by En = (9.57) The quantization of energy in nanocrystals has important technological implications when the material is a semiconductor, in which the electrical conductivity increases with increasing temperature or upon excitation by light (see Chapter 20 for a more detailed discussion). Transfer of energy to a semiconductor increases the mobility of electrons in the material. However, for every electron that moves to a different site in the sample, a unit of positive charge, called a hole, is left behind. The holes are also mobile, so to describe electrical conductivity in semiconductors we need to consider the movement of electron–hole pairs, also called excitons, in the material. The electrons and holes may be regarded as particles trapped in a box, so eqn 9.6 can give us qualitative insight into the origins of conductivity in semiconductors. We conclude as before that only in nanocrystals are the energies of the charge carriers quantized. Now we explore the impact of energy quantization on the optical and electronic properties of semiconducting nanocrystals. Three-dimensional nanocrystals of semiconducting materials containing 103 to 105 atoms are called quantum dots. They can be made in solution or by depositing atoms on a surface, with the size of the nanocrystal being determined by the details of the synthesis (see, for example, Impact I20.2). A quantitative but approximate treatment that leads to the energy of the exciton begins with the following hamiltonian for a spherical quantum dot of radius R: @ = − ∇2 e − ∇2 h + V(re,rh) (9.58) where the first two terms are the kinetic energy operators for the electron and hole (with masses me and mh, respectively), and the third term is the potential energy of interaction between electron and hole, which are located at positions re and rh from the centre of the sphere. Taking into account only the Coulomb attraction between the hole, with charge +e, and the electron, with charge −e, we write (see Chapter 9 and Appendix 3 for details): V(re,rh) = − (9.59) where |re − rh | is the distance between the electron and hole and ε is the permittivity of the medium (we are ignoring the effect of polarization of the medium due to the presence of charges). Solving the Schrödinger equation in this case is not a trivial task, but the final expression for the energy of the exciton, Eex, is relatively simple (see Further reading for details): Eex = + − (9.60) As expected, we see that the energy of the exciton decreases with increasing radius of the quantum dot. Moreover, for small R, the second term on the right of the preceding equation is smaller than the first term and the energy of the exciton is largely kinetic, with the resulting expression resembling the case for a particle in a sphere. The expression for Eex has important consequences for the optical properties of quantum dots. First, we see that the energy required to create mobile charge carriers and to induce electrical conductivity depends on the size of the quantum dot. The 1.8e2 4πεR D F 1 mh 1 me A C h2 8R2 e2 4πε|re − rh | $2 2mh $2 2me n2 h2 8meR2 308 9 QUANTUM THEORY: TECHNIQUES AND APPLICATIONS electrical properties of large, macroscopic samples of semiconductors cannot be tuned in this way. Second, in many quantum dots, such as the nearly spherical nanocrystals of cadmium selenide (CdSe), the exciton can be generated by absorption of visible light. Therefore, we predict that, as the radius of the quantum dot decreases, the excitation wavelength increases. That is, as the size of the quantum dot varies, so does the colour of the material. This phenomenon is indeed observed in suspensions of CdSe quantum dots of different sizes. Because quantum dots are semiconductors with tunable electrical properties, it is easy to imagine uses for these materials in the manufacture of transistors. But the special optical properties of quantum dots can also be exploited. Just as the generation of an electron–hole pair requires absorption of light of a specific wavelength, so does recombination of the pair result in the emission of light of a specific wavelength. This property forms the basis for the use of quantum dots in the visualization of biological cells at work. For example, a CdSe quantum dot can be modified by covalent attachment of an organic spacer to its surface. When the other end of the spacer reacts specifically with a cellular component, such as a protein, nucleic acid, or membrane, the cell becomes labelled with a light-emitting quantum dot. The spatial distribution of emission intensity and, consequently, of the labelled molecule can then be measured with a microscope. Though this technique has been used extensively with organic molecules as labels, quantum dots are more stable and are stronger light emitters. 9.8 Spin Stern and Gerlach observed two bands of Ag atoms in their experiment. This observation seems to conflict with one of the predictions of quantum mechanics, because an angular momentum l gives rise to 2l + 1 orientations, which is equal to 2 only if l = 1 –2, contrary to the conclusion that l must be an integer. The conflict was resolved by the suggestion that the angular momentum they were observing was not due to orbital angular momentum (the motion of an electron around the atomic nucleus) but arose instead from the motion of the electron about its own axis. This intrinsic angular momentum of the electron is called its spin. The explanation of the existence of spin emerged when Dirac combined quantum mechanics with special relativity and established the theory of relativistic quantum mechanics. The spin of an electron about its own axis does not have to satisfy the same boundary conditions as those for a particle circulating around a central point, so the quantum number for spin angular momentum is subject to different restrictions. To distinguish this spin angular momentum from orbital angular momentum we use the spin quantum number s (in place of l; like l, s is a non-negative number) and ms, the spin magnetic quantum number, for the projection on the z-axis. The magnitude of the spin angular momentum is {s(s + 1)}1/2 $ and the component ms$ is restricted to the 2s + 1 values ms = s, s − 1, . . . , −s (9.61) The detailed analysis of the spin of a particle is sophisticated and shows that the property should not be taken to be an actual spinning motion. It is better to regard ‘spin’ as an intrinsic property like mass and charge. However, the picture of an actual spinning motion can be very useful when used with care. For an electron it turns out that only one value of s is allowed, namely s = 1 –2, corresponding to an angular momentum of magnitude (3 –4)1/2 $ = 0.866$. This spin angular momentum is an intrinsic property of the electron, like its rest mass and its charge, and every electron has exactly the same value: the magnitude of the spin angular momentum of an electron cannot be changed. The spin may lie in 2s + 1 = 2 different orientations (Fig. 9.41). ms = + ms = - 2 1 - 2 1 Fig. 9.41 An electron spin (s = 1 –2) can take only two orientations with respect to a specified axis. An α electron (top) is an electron with ms = +1 –2; a β electron (bottom) is an electron with ms = −1 –2. The vector representing the spin angular momentum lies at an angle of 55° to the z-axis (more precisely, the half-angle of the cones is arccos(1/31/2 )). 9.8 SPIN 309 One orientation corresponds to ms = +1 –2 (this state is often denoted α or ↑); the other orientation corresponds to ms = −1 –2 (this state is denoted β or ↓). The outcome of the Stern–Gerlach experiment can now be explained if we suppose that each Ag atom possesses an angular momentum due to the spin of a single electron, because the two bands of atoms then correspond to the two spin orientations. Why the atoms behave like this is explained in Chapter 10 (but it is already probably familiar from introductory chemistry that the ground-state configuration of a silver atom is [Kr]4d10 5s1 , a single unpaired electron outside a closed shell). Like the electron, other elementary particles have characteristic spin. For example, protons and neutrons are spin-1 –2 particles (that is, s = 1 –2) and invariably spin with angular momentum (3 –4)1/2 $ = 0.866$. Because the masses of a proton and a neutron are so much greater than the mass of an electron, yet they all have the same spin angular momentum, the classical picture would be of these two particles spinning much more slowly than an electron. Some elementary particles have s = 1, and so have an intrinsic angular momentum of magnitude 21/2 $. Some mesons are spin-1 particles (as are some atomic nuclei), but for our purposes the most important spin-1 particle is the photon. From the discussion in this chapter, we see that the photon has zero rest mass, zero charge, an energy hν, a linear momentum h/λ or hν/c, an intrinsic angular momentum of 21/2 $, and travels at the speed c. We shall see the importance of photon spin in the next chapter. Particles with half-integral spin are called fermions and those with integral spin (including 0) are called bosons. Thus, electrons and protons are fermions and photons are bosons. It is a very deep feature of nature that all the elementary particles that constitute matter are fermions whereas the elementary particles that are responsible for the forces that bind fermions together are all bosons. Photons, for example, transmit the electromagnetic force that binds together electrically charged particles. Matter, therefore, is an assembly of fermions held together by forces conveyed by bosons. The properties of angular momentum that we have developed are set out in Table 9.4. As mentioned there, when we use the quantum numbers l and ml we shall mean orbital angular momentum (circulation in space). When we use s and ms we shall mean spin angular momentum (intrinsic angular momentum). When we use j and mj we shall mean either (or, in some contexts to be described in Chapter 10, a combination of orbital and spin momenta). Table 9.4 Properties of angular momentum Quantum number Symbol Values* Specifies Orbital angular momentum l 0, 1, 2, . . . Magnitude, {l(l + 1)}1/2 $ Magnetic ml l, l − 1, . . . , −l Component on z-axis, ml$ Spin s 1 –2 Magnitude, {s(s + 1)}1/2 $ Spin magnetic ms ±1 –2 Component on z-axis, ms$ Total j l + s, l + s − 1, . . . , | l − s| Magnitude, {j(j + 1)}1/2 $ Total magnetic mj j, j − 1, . . . , −j Component on z-axis, mj$ To combine two angular momenta, use the Clebsch–Gordan series: j = j1 + j2, j1 + j2 − 1, . . . , |j1 − j2 | For many-electron systems, the quantum numbers are designated by uppercase letters (L, ML, S, MS, etc.). *Note that the quantum numbers for magnitude (l, s, j, etc.) are never negative. 310 9 QUANTUM THEORY: TECHNIQUES AND APPLICATIONS Techniques of approximation All the applications treated so far have had exact solutions. However, many problems —and almost all the problems of interest in chemistry—do not have exact solutions. To make progress with these problems we need to develop techniques of approximation. There are two major approaches, variation theory and perturbation theory. Variation theory is most commonly encountered in the context of molecular orbital theory, and we consider it there (Chapter 11). Here, we concentrate on perturbation theory. 9.9 Time-independent perturbation theory In perturbation theory, we suppose that the hamiltonian for the problem we are trying to solve, @, can be expressed as the sum of a simple hamiltonian, @(0) , which has known eigenvalues and eigenfunctions, and a contribution, @(1) , which represents the extent to which the true hamiltonian differs from the ‘model’ hamiltonian: @ = @(0) + @(1) (9.62) In time-independent perturbation theory, the perturbation is always present and unvarying. For example, it might represent a dip in the potential energy of a particle in a box in some region along the length of the box. In time-independent perturbation theory, we suppose that the true energy of the system differs from the energy of the simple system, and that we can write E = E(0) + E(1) + E(2) + . . . (9.63) where E(1) is the ‘first-order correction’ to the energy, a contribution proportional to @(1) , and E(2) is the ‘second-order correction’ to the energy, a contribution proportional to @(1)2 , and so on. The true wavefunction also differs from the ‘simple’ wavefunction, and we write ψ = ψ(0) + ψ(1) + ψ(2) + . . . (9.64) In practice, we need to consider only the ‘first-order correction’ to the wavefunction, ψ(1) . As we show in Further information 9.2, the first- and second-order corrections to the energy of the ground state (with the wavefunction ψ0 and energy E0), are E0 (1) = Ύψ0 (0) *@(1) ψ0 (0) dτ = H00 (1) (9.65a) and E0 (2) = ∑ n≠0 2 = ∑ n≠0 (9.65b) where we have introduced the matrix element Ωnm = Ύψn*)ψmdτ [9.65c] in a convenient compact notation for integrals that we shall use frequently. As usual, it is important to be able to interpret these equations physically. We can interpret E(1) as the average value of the perturbation, calculated by using the unperturbed wavefunction. An analogy is the shift in energy of vibration of a violin string |Hn0 (1) |2 E0 (0) − En (0) Ύψ0 (0) *@(1) ψ0 (0) dτ E0 (0) − En (0) 9.10 TIME-DEPENDENT PERTURBATION THEORY 311 Large effect No effect Small effect (a) (b) Perturbed wavefunction Fig. 9.42 (a) The first-order energy is an average of the perturbation (represented by the hanging weights) over the unperturbed wavefunction. (b) The second-order energy is a similar average, but over the distortion induced by the perturbation. V 0 L x – sin( / )x L V e p Fig. 9.43 The potential energy for a particle in a box with a potential that varies as −ε sin(πx/L) across the floor of the box. We can expect the particle to accumulate more in the centre of the box (in the ground state at least) than in the unperturbed box. when small weights are hung along its length. The weights hanging close to the nodes have little effect on its energy of vibration. Those hanging at the antinodes, however, have a pronounced effect (Fig. 9.42a). The second-order energy represents a similar average of the perturbation, but now the average is taken over the perturbed wavefunctions. In terms of the violin analogy, the average is now taken over the distorted waveform of the vibrating string, in which the nodes and antinodes are slightly shifted (Fig. 9.42b). We should note the following three features of eqn 9.65b: 1. Because En(0) > E0(0), all the terms in the denominator are negative and, because the numerators are all positive, the second-order correction is negative, which represents a lowering of the energy of the ground state. 2. The perturbation appears (as its square) in the numerator; so the stronger the perturbation, the greater the lowering of the ground-state energy. 3. If the energy levels of the system are widely spaced, all the denominators are large, so the sum is likely to be small; in which case the perturbation has little effect on the energy of the system: the system is ‘stiff’, and unresponsive to perturbations. The opposite is true when the energy levels lie close together. Example 9.5 Using perturbation theory Find the first-order correction to the ground-state energy for a particle in a well with a variation in the potential of the form V = −ε sin(πx/L), as in Fig. 9.43. Method Identify the first-order perturbation hamiltonian and evaluate E0 (1) from eqn 9.65a. We can expect a small lowering of the energy because the average potential energy of the particle is lower in the distorted box. Answer The perturbation hamiltonian is @(1) = −ε sin(πx/L) Therefore, the first-order correction to the energy is 4L/3π E0 (1) = Ύ L 0 ψ1@(1) ψ1dx = − Ύ L 0 sin3 dx = − Note that the energy is lowered by the perturbation, as would be expected for the shape shown in Fig. 9.43. Self-test 9.9 Suppose that only ψ3 contributes to the distortion of the wavefunction: calculate the coefficient c3 and the second-order correction to the energy by using eqn 9.65b and eqn 9.76 in Further information 9.2. [c3 = −8εmL2 /15πh2 , E0 (2) = −64ε2 mL2 /225π2 h2 ] 9.10 Time-dependent perturbation theory In time-dependent perturbation theory, the perturbation is either switched on and allowed to rise to its final value or is varying in time. Many of the perturbations encountered in chemistry are time-dependent. The most important is the effect of an oscillating electromagnetic field, which is responsible for spectroscopic transitions between quantized energy levels in atoms and molecules. 8ε 3π πx L 2ε L 5 4 6 4 7 312 9 QUANTUM THEORY: TECHNIQUES AND APPLICATIONS Classically, for a molecule to be able to interact with the electromagnetic field and absorb or emit a photon of frequency ν, it must possess, at least transiently, a dipole oscillating at that frequency. In this section, we develop the quantum mechanical view and begin by writing the hamiltonian for the system as @ = @(0) + @(1) (t) (9.66) where @(1) (t) is the time-dependent perturbation. Because the perturbation arises from the effect of an oscillating electric field with the electric dipole moment, we write @(1) (t) = −µzE cos ωt (9.67) where ω is the frequency of the field and E is its amplitude. We suppose that the perturbation is absent until t = 0, and then it is turned on. We show in Further information 9.2 that the rate of change of population of the state ψf due to transitions from state ψi, wf←i, is proportional to the square modulus of the matrix element of the perturbation between the two states: wf←i ∝ |Hfi (1) |2 (9.68) Because in our case the perturbation is that of the interaction of the electromagnetic field with a molecule (eqn 9.67), we conclude that wf←i ∝ |µz,fi |2 E2 (9.69) Therefore, the rate of transition, and hence the intensity of absorption of the incident radiation, is proportional to the square of the transition dipole moment: µz,fi = Ύψf*µzψidτ [9.70] The size of the transition dipole can be regarded as a measure of the charge redistribution that accompanies a transition. The rate of transition is also proportional to E2 , and therefore the intensity of the incident radiation (because the intensity is proportional to E2 ; see Appendix 3). This result will be the basis of most of our subsequent discussion of spectroscopy in Chapters 10 and 13–15 and of the kinetics of electron transfer in Chapter 24. Comment 9.8 An electric dipole consists of two electric charges +q and −q separated by a distance R. The electric dipole moment vector µ has a magnitude µ = qR. Checklist of key ideas 1. The wavefunction of a free particle is ψk = Aeikx + Be−ikx , Ek = k2 $2 /2m. 2. The wavefunctions and energies of a particle in a onedimensional box of length L are, respectively, ψn(x) = (2/L)1/2 sin(nπx/L) and En = n2 h2 /8mL2 , n = 1,2, . . . . The zero-point energy, the lowest possible energy is E1 = h2 /8mL2 . 3. The correspondence principle states that classical mechanics emerges from quantum mechanics as high quantum numbers are reached. 4. The functions ψn and ψn′ are orthogonal if ∫ψn*ψn′dτ = 0; all wavefunctions corresponding to different energies of a system are orthogonal. Orthonormal functions are sets of functions that are normalized and mutually orthogonal. 5. The wavefunctions and energies of a particle in a twodimensional box are given by eqn 9.12a. 6. Degenerate wavefunctions are different wavefunctions corresponding to the same energy. 7. Tunnelling is the penetration into or through classically forbidden regions. The transmission probability is given by eqn 9.20a. 8. Harmonic motion is the motion in the presence of a restoring force proportional to the displacement, F = −kx, where k is the force constant. As a consequence, V = 1 –2kx2 . 9. The wavefunctions and energy levels of a quantum mechanical harmonic oscillator are given by eqns 9.28 and 9.25, respectively. 10. The virial theorem states that, if the potential energy of a particle has the form V = axb , then its mean potential and kinetic energies are related by 2͗EK͘ = b͗V͘. 11. Angular momentum is the moment of linear momentum around a point. FURTHER INFORMATION 313 12. The wavefunctions and energies of a particle on a ring are, respectively, ψml (φ) = (1/2π)1/2 eimlφ and E = ml 2 $2 /2I, with I = mr2 and ml = 0, ±1, ±2, . . . . 13. The wavefunctions of a particle on a sphere are the spherical harmonics, the functions Yl,ml (θ,φ) (Table 9.3). The energies are E = l(l + 1)$2 /2I, l = 0, 1, 2, . . . . 14. For a particle on a sphere, the magnitude of the angular momentum is {l(l + 1)}1/2 $ and the z-component of the angular momentum is ml$, ml = l, l − 1, . . . , −l. 15. Space quantization is the restriction of the component of angular momentum around an axis to discrete values. 16. Spin is an intrinsic angular momentum of a fundamental particle. A fermion is a particle with a half-integral spin quantum number; a boson is a particle with an integral spin quantum number. 17. For an electron, the spin quantum number is s = 1 –2. 18. The spin magnetic quantum number is ms = s, s − 1, . . . , −s; for an electron, ms = +1 –2, −1 –2. 19. Perturbation theory is a technique that supplies approximate solutions to the Schrödinger equation and in which the hamiltonian for the problem is expressed as a sum of simpler hamiltonians. 20. In time-independent perturbation theory, the perturbation is always present and unvarying. The first- and second-order corrections to the energy are given by eqns 9.65a and 9.65b, respectively. In time-dependent perturbation theory, the perturbation is either switched on and allowed to rise to its final value or is varying in time. 21. The rate of change of population of the state ψf due to transitions from state ψi is wf←i ∝ |µz,fi |2 E2 , where µz,fi = ∫ψf*µzψidτ is the transition dipole moment. Further reading Articles and texts P.W. Atkins and R.S. Friedman, Molecular quantum mechanics. Oxford University Press (2005). C.S. Johnson, Jr. and L.G. Pedersen, Problems and solutions in quantum chemistry and physics. Dover, New York (1986). I.N. Levine, Quantum chemistry. Prentice–Hall, Upper Saddle River (2000). D.A. McQuarrie, Mathematical methods for scientists and engineers. University Science Books, Mill Valley (2003). J.J.C. Mulder, Closed-form spherical harmonics: explicit polynomial expression for the associated legendre functions. J. Chem. Educ. 77, 244 (2000). L. Pauling and E.B. Wilson, Introduction to quantum mechanics with applications to chemistry. Dover, New York (1985). Further information Further information 9.1 Dirac notation The integral in eqn 9.9 is often written ͗n|n′͘ = 0 (n′ ≠ n) This Dirac bracket notation is much more succinct than writing out the integral in full. It also introduces the words ‘bra’ and ‘ket’ into the language of quantum mechanics. Thus, the bra ͗n| corresponds to ψn* and the ket |n′͘ corresponds to the wavefunction ψn′. When the bra and ket are put together as in this expression, the integration over all space is understood. Similarly, the normalization condition in eqn 8.17c becomes simply ͗n|n͘ = 1 in bracket notation. These two expressions can be combined into one: ͗n|n′͘ = δnn′ (9.71) Here δnn′, which is called the Kronecker delta, is 1 when n′ = n and 0 when n′ ≠ n. Integrals of the form ∫ψn*)ψmdτ, which we first encounter in connection with perturbation theory (Section 9.9) and which are commonly called ‘matrix elements’, are incorporated into the bracket notation by writing ͗n|)|m͘ = Ύψn*)ψmdτ [9.72] Note how the operator stands between the bra and the ket (which may denote different states), in the place of the c in ͗bra|c|ket͘. An integration is implied whenever a complete bracket is written. In this notation, an expectation value is ͗Ω͘ = ͗n|)|n͘ (9.73) with the bra and the ket corresponding to the same state (with quantum number n and wavefunction ψn). In this notation, an operator is hermitian (eqn 8.30) if ͗n|)|m͘ = ͗m|)|n͘* (9.74) Further information 9.2 Perturbation theory Here we treat perturbation theory in detail. Our first task is to develop the results of time-independent perturbation theory, in which a system is subjected to a perturbation that does not vary with 314 9 QUANTUM THEORY: TECHNIQUES AND APPLICATIONS Ύψ 0 (0) *ψ n (0) dτ = 0 if n ≠ 0, but 1 if n = 0 Therefore, when we multiply through by ψ 0 (0) * and integrate over all space, we get E0 (0) if n=0, 0 otherwise Ύψ 0 (0) *@(1) ψ 0 (0) dτ + ∑n cn Ύψ 0 (0) *@(0)ψ n (0) dτ 1 if n=0, 0 otherwise 1 = ∑n cnE0 (0) Ύψ 0 (0) *ψ n (0) dτ + E0 (1) Ύψ 0 (0) *ψ 0 (0) dτ That is, Ύψ 0 (0) *@(1) ψ 0 (0) dτ = E0 (1) which is eqn 9.65a. To find the coefficients cn, we multiply the same expression through by ψk (0) *, where now k ≠ 0, which gives Ek (0) δkn Ύψ k (0) *@(1) ψ 0 (0) dτ + ∑n cn Ύψ k (0) *@(0) ψ n (0) dτ 1 if n=k, 0 otherwise 0 = ∑n cnE0 (0) Ύψ k (0) *ψ n (0) dτ + E0 (1) Ύψ k (0) *ψ 0 (0) dτ That is, Ύψ k (0) *@(1) ψ 0 (0) dτ + ckEk (0) = ckE0 (0) which we can rearrange into ck = − (9.76) The second-order energy is obtained starting from the secondorder expression, which for the ground state is @(0) ψ 0 (2) + @(1) ψ 0 (1) = E0 (2) ψ 0 (0) + E0 (1) ψ 0 (1) + E0 (0) ψ 0 (2) To isolate the term E 0 (2) we multiply both sides by ψ 0 (0) *, integrate over all space, and obtain E0 (0) ∫ψ0 (0)* ψ 0 (2) dτ Ύψ 0 (0) *@(0) ψ 0 (2) dτ + Ύψ 0 (0) *@(1) ψ 0 (1) dτ = E0 (2) Ύψ 0 (0) *ψ 0 (0) dτ + E0 (1) Ύψ 0 (0) *ψ 0 (1) dτ + E0 (0) Ύψ 0 (0) *ψ 0 (2) dτ 1 The first and last terms cancel, and we are left with E 0 (2) = Ύψ 0 (0) *@(1) ψ 0 (1) dτ − E0 (1) Ύψ 0 (0) *ψ 0 (1) dτ 1 4 2 4 3 5 4 4 6 4 4 7 Ύψ k (0) *@(1) ψ 0 (0) dτ Ek (0) − E0 (0) 5 4 6 4 7 5 4 6 4 75 4 4 6 4 4 7 5 4 6 4 7 5 4 6 4 75 4 4 6 4 4 7 time. Then, we go on to discuss time-dependent perturbation theory, in which a perturbation is turned on at a specific time and the system is allowed to evolve. 1 Time-independent perturbation theory To develop expressions for the corrections to the wavefunction and energy of a system subjected to a time-independent perturbation, we write ψ = ψ(0) + λψ(1) + λ2 ψ(2) + . . . where the power of λ indicates the order of the correction. Likewise, we write @ = @(0) + λ@(1) and E = E(0) + λE(1) + λ2 E(2) + . . . When these expressions are inserted into the Schrödinger equation, @ψ = Eψ, we obtain (@(0) + λ@(1) )(ψ(0) + λψ(1) + λ2 ψ(2) + . . . ) = (E(0) + λE(1) + λ2 E(2) + . . . )(ψ(0) + λψ(1) + λ2 ψ(2) + . . . ) which we can rewrite as @(0) ψ(0) + λ(@(1) ψ(0) + @(0) ψ(1) ) + λ2 (@(0) ψ(2) + @(1) ψ(1) ) + . . . = E(0) ψ(0) + λ(E(0) ψ(1) + E(1) ψ(0) ) + λ2 (E(2) ψ(0) + E(1) ψ(1) + E(0) ψ(2) ) + . . . By comparing powers of λ, we find Terms in λ0 : @(0) ψ(0) = E(0) ψ(0) Terms in λ: @(1) ψ(0) + @(0) ψ(1) = E(0) ψ(1) + E(1) ψ(0) Terms in λ2 : @(0) ψ(2) + @(1) ψ(1) = E(2) ψ(0) + E(1) ψ(1) + E(0) ψ(2) and so on. The equations we have derived are applicable to any state of the system. From now on we shall consider only the ground state ψ0 with energy E0. The first equation, which we now write @(0) ψ0 (0) = E0 (0) ψ0 (0) is the Schrödinger equation for the ground state of the unperturbed system, which we assume we can solve (for instance, it might be the equation for the ground state of the particle in a box, with the solutions given in eqn 9.7). To solve the next equation, which is now written @(1) ψ 0 (0) + @(0) ψ 0 (1) = E0 (0) ψ(1) + E0 (1) ψ 0 (0) we suppose that the first-order correction to the wavefunction can be expressed as a linear combination of the wavefunctions of the unperturbed system, and write ψ 0 (1) = ∑n cnψ n (0) (9.75) Substitution of this expression gives @(1) ψ 0 (0) + ∑n cn@(0) ψ n (0) = ∑n cnE0 (0) ψ n (0) + E0 (1) ψ 0 (0) We can isolate the term in E0 (1) by making use of the fact that the ψ n (0) form a complete orthogonal and normalized set in the sense that FURTHER INFORMATION 315 We have already found the first-order corrections to the energy and the wavefunction, so this expression could be regarded as an explicit expression for the second-order energy. However, we can go one step further by substituting eqn 9.75: H0n (1) δ0n E0 (2) = ∑n cn Ύψ 0 (0) *@(1) ψ n (0) dτ − ∑n cn E0 (1) Ύψ 0 (0) *ψ n (0) dτ = ∑n cnH(1) 0n − c0E(1) 0 The final term cancels the term c0H00 (1) in the sum, and we are left with E0 (2) = ∑n≠0 cnH(1) 0n Substitution of the expression for cn in eqn 9.76 now produces the final result, eqn 9.65b. 2 Time-dependent perturbation theory To cope with a perturbed wavefunction that evolves with time, we need to solve the time-dependent Schrödinger equation, @Ψ = i$ (9.77) We confirm below, that if we write the first-order correction to the wavefunction as Ψ 0 (1) (t) = ∑n cn(t)Ψn(t) = ∑n cn(t)ψ n (0) e−iEn (0) t/$ (9.78a) then the coefficients in this expansion are given by cn(t) = Ύ0 t H(1) n0 (t)eiωn0t dt (9.78b) The formal demonstration of eqn 9.78 is quite lengthy (see Further reading). Here we shall show that, given eqn 9.78b, a perturbation that is switched on very slowly to a constant value gives the same expression for the coefficients as we obtained for time-independent perturbation theory. For such a perturbation, we write @(1) (t) = @(1) (1 − e−t/τ ) and take the time constant τ to be very long (Fig. 9.44). Substitution of this expression into eqn 9.78b gives cn(t) = H(1) n0 Ύ0 t (1 − e−t/τ )eiωn0t dt = H(1) n0 − 5 6 7 e(iωn0−1/τ)t − 1 iωn0 − 1/τ eiωn0t − 1 iωn0 1 2 3 1 i$ 1 i$ 1 i$ ∂Ψ ∂t 5 4 6 4 7 5 4 4 6 4 4 7 At this point we suppose that the perturbation is switched slowly, in the sense that τ >> 1/ωn0 (so that the 1/τ in the second denominator can be ignored). We also suppose that we are interested in the coefficients long after the perturbation has settled down into its final value, when t >> τ (so that the exponential in the second numerator is close to zero and can be ignored). Under these conditions, cn(t) = − eiωn0t Now we recognize that $ωn0 = En (0) − E0 (0) , which gives cn(t) = − eiEn (0)t e−iE0 (0) t When this expression is substituted into eqn 9.78a, we obtain the time-independent expression, eqn 9.76 (apart from an irrelevant overall phase factor). In accord with the general rules for the interpretation of wavefunctions, the probability that the system will be found in the state n is proportional to the square modulus of the coefficient of the state, |cn(t)|2 . Therefore, the rate of change of population of a final state ψf due to transitions from an initial state ψi is wf←i = = = cf + cf * Because the coefficients are proportional to the matrix elements of the perturbation, wf←i is proportional to the square modulus of the matrix element of the perturbation between the two states: wf←i ∝ |Hfi (1) |2 which is eqn 9.68. dcf dt dcf * dt dcf *cf dt d|cf |2 dt H(0) n0 En (0) − E0 (0) H(0) n0 $ωn0 Time, t H(1) long short H t(1) ( ) t t Fig. 9.44 The time-dependence of a slowly switched perturbation. A large value of τ corresponds to very slow switching. 316 9 QUANTUM THEORY: TECHNIQUES AND APPLICATIONS Discussion questions 9.1 Discuss the physical origin of quantization energy for a particle confined to moving inside a one-dimensional box or on a ring. 9.2 Discuss the correspondence principle and provide two examples. 9.3 Define, justify, and provide examples of zero-point energy. 9.4 Discuss the physical origins of quantum mechanical tunnelling. Why is tunnelling more likely to contribute to the mechanisms of electron transfer and proton transfer processes than to mechanisms of group transfer reactions, such as AB + C → A + BC (where A, B, and C are large molecular groups)? 9.5 Distinguish between a fermion and a boson. Provide examples of each type of particle. 9.6 Describe the features that stem from nanometre-scale dimensions that are not found in macroscopic objects. Exercises 9.1a Calculate the energy separations in joules, kilojoules per mole, electronvolts, and reciprocal centimetres between the levels (a) n = 2 and n = 1, (b) n = 6 and n = 5 of an electron in a box of length 1.0 nm. 9.1b Calculate the energy separations in joules, kilojoules per mole, electronvolts, and reciprocal centimetres between the levels (a) n = 3 and n = 1, (b) n = 7 and n = 6 of an electron in a box of length 1.50 nm. 9.2a Calculate the probability that a particle will be found between 0.49L and 0.51L in a box of length L when it has (a) n = 1, (b) n = 2. Take the wavefunction to be a constant in this range. 9.2b Calculate the probability that a particle will be found between 0.65L and 0.67L in a box of length L when it has (a) n = 1, (b) n = 2. Take the wavefunction to be a constant in this range. 9.3a Calculate the expectation values of p and p2 for a particle in the state n = 1 in a square-well potential. 9.3b Calculate the expectation values of p and p2 for a particle in the state n = 2 in a square-well potential. 9.4a An electron is confined to a a square well of length L. What would be the length of the box such that the zero-point energy of the electron is equal to its rest mass energy, mec2 ? Express your answer in terms of the parameter λC = h/mec, the ‘Compton wavelength’ of the electron. 9.4b Repeat Exercise 9.4a for a general particle of mass m in a cubic box. 9.5a What are the most likely locations of a particle in a box of length L in the state n = 3? 9.5b What are the most likely locations of a particle in a box of length L in the state n = 5? 9.6a Consider a particle in a cubic box. What is the degeneracy of the level that has an energy three times that of the lowest level? 9.6b Consider a particle in a cubic box. What is the degeneracy of the level that has an energy 14 ––3 times that of the lowest level? 9.7a Calculate the percentage change in a given energy level of a particle in a cubic box when the length of the edge of the cube is decreased by 10 per cent in each direction. 9.7b A nitrogen molecule is confined in a cubic box of volume 1.00 m3 . Assuming that the molecule has an energy equal to 3 –2kT at T = 300 K, what is the value of n = (nx 2 + ny 2 + nz 2 )1/2 for this molecule? What is the energy separation between the levels n and n + 1? What is its de Broglie wavelength? Would it be appropriate to describe this particle as behaving classically? 9.8a Calculate the zero-point energy of a harmonic oscillator consisting of a particle of mass 2.33 × 10−26 kg and force constant 155 N m−1 . 9.8b Calculate the zero-point energy of a harmonic oscillator consisting of a particle of mass 5.16 × 10−26 kg and force constant 285 N m−1 . 9.9a For a harmonic oscillator of effective mass 1.33 × 10−25 kg, the difference in adjacent energy levels is 4.82 zJ. Calculate the force constant of the oscillator. 9.9b For a harmonic oscillator of effective mass 2.88 × 10−25 kg, the difference in adjacent energy levels is 3.17 zJ. Calculate the force constant of the oscillator. 9.10a Calculate the wavelength of a photon needed to excite a transition between neighbouring energy levels of a harmonic oscillator of effective mass equal to that of a proton (1.0078 u) and force constant 855 N m−1 . 9.10b Calculate the wavelength of a photon needed to excite a transition between neighbouring energy levels of a harmonic oscillator of effective mass equal to that of an oxygen atom (15.9949 u) and force constant 544 N m−1 . 9.11a Refer to Exercise 9.10a and calculate the wavelength that would result from doubling the effective mass of the oscillator. 9.11b Refer to Exercise 9.10b and calculate the wavelength that would result from doubling the effective mass of the oscillator. 9.12a Calculate the minimum excitation energies of (a) a pendulum of length 1.0 m on the surface of the Earth, (b) the balance-wheel of a clockwork watch (ν = 5 Hz). 9.12b Calculate the minimum excitation energies of (a) the 33 kHz quartz crystal of a watch, (b) the bond between two O atoms in O2, for which k = 1177 N m−1 . 9.13a Confirm that the wavefunction for the ground state of a onedimensional linear harmonic oscillator given in Table 9.1 is a solution of the Schrödinger equation for the oscillator and that its energy is 1 –2$ω. 9.13b Confirm that the wavefunction for the first excited state of a onedimensional linear harmonic oscillator given in Table 9.1 is a solution of the Schrödinger equation for the oscillator and that its energy is 3 –2$ω. 9.14a Locate the nodes of the harmonic oscillator wavefunction with v = 4. 9.14b Locate the nodes of the harmonic oscillator wavefunction with v = 5. 9.15a Assuming that the vibrations of a 35 Cl2 molecule are equivalent to those of a harmonic oscillator with a force constant k = 329 N m−1 , what is the zeropoint energy of vibration of this molecule? The mass of a 35 Cl atom is 34.9688 u. 9.15b Assuming that the vibrations of a 14 N2 molecule are equivalent to those of a harmonic oscillator with a force constant k = 2293.8 N m−1 , what is the zero-point energy of vibration of this molecule? The mass of a 14 N atom is 14.0031 u. PROBLEMS 317 9.16a The wavefunction, ψ(φ), for the motion of a particle in a ring is of the form ψ = Neimlφ . Determine the normalization constant, N. 9.16b Confirm that wavefunctions for a particle in a ring with different values of the quantum number ml are mutually orthogonal. 9.17a A point mass rotates in a circle with l = 1, Calculate the magnitude of its angular momentum and the possible projections of the angular momentum on an arbitrary axis. 9.17b A point mass rotates in a circle with l = 2, Calculate the magnitude of its angular momentum and the possible projections of the angular momentum on an arbitrary axis. 9.18a Draw scale vector diagrams to represent the states (a) s = 1 –2, ms = + 1 –2, (b) l = 1, ml = +1, (c) l = 2, ml = 0. 9.18b Draw the vector diagram for all the permitted states of a particle with l = 6. Problems* Numerical problems 9.1 Calculate the separation between the two lowest levels for an O2 molecule in a one-dimensional container of length 5.0 cm. At what value of n does the energy of the molecule reach 1 –2kT at 300 K, and what is the separation of this level from the one immediately below? 9.2 The mass to use in the expression for the vibrational frequency of a diatomic molecule is the effective mass µ = mAmB/(mA + mB), where mA and mB are the masses of the individual atoms. The following data on the infrared absorption wavenumbers (in cm−1 ) of molecules are taken from Spectra of diatomic molecules, G. Herzberg, van Nostrand (1950): H35 Cl H81 Br HI CO NO 2990 2650 2310 2170 1904 Calculate the force constants of the bonds and arrange them in order of increasing stiffness. 9.3 The rotation of an 1 H127 I molecule can be pictured as the orbital motion of an H atom at a distance 160 pm from a stationary I atom. (This picture is quite good; to be precise, both atoms rotate around their common centre of mass, which is very close to the I nucleus.) Suppose that the molecule rotates only in a plane. Calculate the energy needed to excite the molecule into rotation. What, apart from 0, is the minimum angular momentum of the molecule? 9.4 Calculate the energies of the first four rotational levels of 1 H127 I free to rotate in three dimensions, using for its moment of inertia I = µR2 , with µ = mHmI/(mH + mI) and R = 160 pm. 9.5 A small step in the potential energy is introduced into the onedimensional square-well problem as in Fig. 9.45. (a) Write a general expression for the first-order correction to the ground-state energy, E0 (1) . (b) Evaluate the energy correction for a = L/10 (so the blip in the potential occupies the central 10 per cent of the well), with n = 1. 9.6 We normally think of the one-dimensional well as being horizontal. Suppose it is vertical; then the potential energy of the particle depends on x because of the presence of the gravitational field. Calculate the first-order correction to the zero-point energy, and evaluate it for an electron in a box on the surface of the Earth. Account for the result. Hint. The energy of the particle depends on its height as mgh, where g = 9.81 m s−2 . Because g is so small, the energy correction is small; but it would be significant if the box were near a very massive star. 9.7 Calculate the second-order correction to the energy for the system described in Problem 9.6 and calculate the ground-state wavefunction. Account for the shape of the distortion caused by the perturbation. Hint. The following integrals are useful Ύx sin ax sin bxdx = − Ύcos ax sin bxdx Ύcos ax sin bxdx = − + constant Theoretical problems 9.8 Suppose that 1.0 mol perfect gasmolecules all occupy the lowest energy level of a cubic box. How much work must be done to change the volume of the box by ∆V? Would the work be different if the molecules all occupied a state n ≠ 1? What is the relevance of this discussion to the expression for the expansion work discussed in Chapter 2? Can you identify a distinction between adiabatic and isothermal expansion? 9.9 Derive eqn 9.20a, the expression for the transmission probability. 9.10‡ Consider the one-dimensional space in which a particle can experience one of three potentials depending upon its position. They are: V = 0 for −∞ < x ≤ 0, 0, V = V2 for 0 ≤ x ≤ L, and V = V3 for L ≤ x < ∞. The particle wavefunction is to have both a component eik1x that is incident upon the barrier V2 and a reflected component e−ik1x in region 1 (−∞ < x ≤ 0). In region 3 the wavefunction has only a forward component, eik3x , which represents a particle that has traversed the barrier. The energy of the particle, E, is somewhere in the range of the V2 > E > V3. The transmission probability, T, is the ratio of the square modulus of the region 3 amplitude to the square modulus of the incident amplitude. (a) Base your calculation on the continuity of the amplitudes and the slope of the wavefunction at the locations of the zone boundaries and derive a general equation for T. (b) Show that the general equation for T reduces to eqn 9.20b in the high, wide barrier limit when cos(a + b)x 2(a + b) cos(a − b)x 2(a − b) d da * Problems denoted with the symbol ‡ were supplied by Charles Trapp, Carmen Giunta, and Marshall Cady. x a 0 L/2 L e Potentialenergy,V Fig. 9.45 318 9 QUANTUM THEORY: TECHNIQUES AND APPLICATIONS V1 = V3 = 0. (c) Draw a graph of the probability of proton tunnelling when V3 = 0, L = 50 pm, and E = 10 kJ mol−1 in the barrier range E < V2 < 2E. 9.11 The wavefunction inside a long barrier of height V is ψ = Ne−κx . Calculate (a) the probability that the particle is inside the barrier and (b) the average penetration depth of the particle into the barrier. 9.12 Confirm that a function of the form e−gx2 is a solution of the Schrödinger equation for the ground state of a harmonic oscillator and find an expression for g in terms of the mass and force constant of the oscillator. 9.13 Calculate the mean kinetic energy of a harmonic oscillator by using the relations in Table 9.1. 9.14 Calculate the values of ͗x3 ͘ and ͗x4 ͘ for a harmonic oscillator by using the relations in Table 9.1. 9.15 Determine the values of δx = (͗x2 ͘ − ͗x͘2 )1/2 and δp = (͗p2 ͘ − ͗p͘2 )1/2 for (a) a particle in a box of length L and (b) a harmonic oscillator. Discuss these quantities with reference to the uncertainty principle. 9.16 We shall see in Chapter 13 that the intensities of spectroscopic transitions between the vibrational states of a molecule are proportional to the square of the integral ∫ψv′xψvdx over all space. Use the relations between Hermite polynomials given in Table 9.1 to show that the only permitted transitions are those for which v′ = v ± 1 and evaluate the integral in these cases. 9.17 The potential energy of the rotation of one CH3 group relative to its neighbour in ethane can be expressed as V(ϕ) = V0 cos 3ϕ. Show that for small displacements the motion of the group is harmonic and calculate the energy of excitation from v = 0 to v = 1. What do you expect to happen to the energy levels and wavefunctions as the excitation increases? 9.18 Show that, whatever superposition of harmonic oscillator states is used to construct a wavepacket, it is localized at the same place at the times 0, T, 2T, . . . , where T is the classical period of the oscillator. 9.19 Use the virial theorem to obtain an expression for the relation between the mean kinetic and potential energies of an electron in a hydrogen atom. 9.20 Evaluate the z-component of the angular momentum and the kinetic energy of a particle on a ring that is described by the (unnormalized) wavefunctions (a) eiφ , (b) e−2iφ , (c) cos φ, and (d) (cos χ)eiφ + (sin χ)e−iφ . 9.21 Is the Schrödinger equation for a particle on an elliptical ring of semimajor axes a and b separable? Hint. Although r varies with angle ϕ, the two are related by r2 = a2 sin2 φ + b2 cos2 φ. 9.22 Use mathematical software to construct a wavepacket of the form Ψ(φ,t) = ∑ml=0 ml,max cml ei(mlφ−Eml t/$) Eml = ml 2 $2 /2I with coefficients c of your choice (for example, all equal). Explore how the wavepacket migrates on the ring but spreads with time. 9.23 Confirm that the spherical harmonics (a) Y0,0, (b) Y2,−1, and (c) Y3,+3 satisfy the Schrödinger equation for a particle free to rotate in three dimensions, and find its energy and angular momentum in each case. 9.24 Confirm that Y3,+3 is normalized to 1. (The integration required is over the surface of a sphere.) 9.25 Derive an expression in terms of l and ml for the half-angle of the apex of the cone used to represent an angular momentum according to the vector model. Evaluate the expression for an α spin. Show that the minimum possible angle approaches 0 as l → ∞. 9.26 Show that the function f = cos ax cos cos cz is an eigenfunction of ∇2 , and determine its eigenvalue. 9.27 Derive (in Cartesian coordinates) the quantum mechanical operators for the three components of angular momentum starting from the classical definition of angular momentum, l = r × p. Show that any two of the components do not mutually commute, and find their commutator. 9.28 Starting from the operator lz = xpy − ypx, prove that in spherical polar coordinates lz = −i$∂/∂φ. 9.29 Show that the commutator [l2 ,lz] = 0, and then, without further calculation, justify the remark that [l2 ,lq] = 0 for all q = x, y, and z. 9.30‡ A particle is confined to move in a one-dimensional box of length L. (a) If the particle is classical, show that the average value of x is 1 –2L and that the root-mean square value is L/31/2 . (b) Show that for large values of n, a quantum particle approaches the classical values. This result is an example of the correspondence principle, which states that, for very large values of the quantum numbers, the predictions of quantum mechanics approach those of classical mechanics. Applications: to biology and nanotechnology 9.31 When β-carotene is oxidized in vivo, it breaks in half and forms two molecules of retinal (vitamin A), which is a precursor to the pigment in the retina responsible for vision (Impact I14.1). The conjugated system of retinal consists of 11 C atoms and one O atom. In the ground state of retinal, each level up to n = 6 is occupied by two electrons. Assuming an average internuclear distance of 140 pm, calculate (a) the separation in energy between the ground state and the first excited state in which one electron occupies the state with n = 7, and (b) the frequency of the radiation required to produce a transition between these two states. (c) Using your results and Illustration 9.1, choose among the words in parentheses to generate a rule for the prediction of frequency shifts in the absorption spectra of linear polyenes: The absorption spectrum of a linear polyene shifts to (higher/lower) frequency as the number of conjugated atoms (increases/decreases). 9.32 Many biological electron transfer reactions, such as those associated with biological energy conversion, may be visualized as arising from electron tunnelling between protein-bound co-factors, such as cytochromes, quinones, flavins, and chlorophylls. This tunnelling occurs over distances that are often greater than 1.0 nm, with sections of protein separating electron donor from acceptor. For a specific combination of donor and acceptor, the rate of electron tunnelling is proportional to the transmission probability, with κ ≈ 7 nm−1 (eqn 9.20). By what factor does the rate of electron tunnelling between two co-factors increase as the distance between them changes from 2.0 nm to 1.0 nm? 9.33 Carbon monoxide binds strongly to the Fe2+ ion of the haem group of the protein myoglobin. Estimate the vibrational frequency of CO bound to myoglobin by using the data in Problem 9.2 and by making the following assumptions: the atom that binds to the haem group is immobilized, the protein is infinitely more massive than either the C or O atom, the C atom binds to the Fe2+ ion, and binding of CO to the protein does not alter the force constant of the C.O bond. 9.34 Of the four assumptions made in Problem 9.33, the last two are questionable. Suppose that the first two assumptions are still reasonable and that you have at your disposal a supply of myoglobin, a suitable buffer in which to suspend the protein, 12 C16 O, 13 C16 O, 12 C18 O, 13 C18 O, and an infrared spectrometer. Assuming that isotopic substitution does not affect the force constant of the C.O bond, describe a set of experiments that: (a) proves which atom, C or O, binds to the haem group of myoglobin, and (b) allows for the determination of the force constant of the C.O bond for myoglobinbound carbon monoxide. 9.35 The particle on a ring is a useful model for the motion of electrons around the porphine ring (2), the conjugated macrocycle that forms the PROBLEMS 319 structural basis of the haem group and the chlorophylls. We may treat the group as a circular ring of radius 440 pm, with 22 electrons in the conjugated system moving along the perimeter of the ring. As in Illustration 9.1, we assume that in the ground state of the molecule quantized each state is occupied by two electrons. (a) Calculate the energy and angular momentum of an electron in the highest occupied level. (b) Calculate the frequency of radiation that can induce a transition between the highest occupied and lowest unoccupied levels. 9.36 When in Chapter 19 we come to study macromolecules, such as synthetic polymers, proteins, and nucleic acids, we shall see that one conformation is that of a random coil. For a one-dimensional random coil of N units, the restoring force at small displacements and at a temperature T is F = − ln where l is the length of each monomer unit and nl is the distance between the ends of the chain (see Section 19.8). Show that for small extensions (n << N) the restoring force is proportional to n and therefore the coil undergoes harmonic oscillation with force constant kT/Nl2 . Suppose that the mass to use for the vibrating chain is its total mass Nm, where m is the mass of one monomer unit, and deduce the root mean square separation of the ends of the chain due to quantum fluctuations in its vibrational ground state. 9.37 The forces measured by AFM arise primarily from interactions between electrons of the stylus and on the surface. To get an idea of the magnitudes of these forces, calculate the force acting between two electrons separated by 2.0 nm. Hints. The Coulombic potential energy of a charge q1 at a distance r from another charge q2 is V = where ε0 = 8.854 × 10−12 C2 J−1 m−1 is the vacuum permittivity.To calculate the force between the electrons, note that F = −dV/dr. q1q2 4πε0r D E F N + n N − n A B C kT 2l 9.38 Here we explore further the idea introduced in Impact I9.2 that quantum mechanical effects need to be invoked in the description of the electronic properties of metallic nanocrystals, here modelled as three-dimensional boxes. (a) Set up the Schrödinger equation for a particle of mass m in a threedimensional rectangular box with sides L1, L2, and L3. Show that the Schrödinger equation is separable. (b) Show that the wavefunction and the energy are defined by three quantum numbers. (c) Specialize the result from part (b) to an electron moving in a cubic box of side L = 5 nm and draw an energy diagram resembling Fig. 9.2 and showing the first 15 energy levels. Note that each energy level may consist of degenerate energy states. (d) Compare the energy level diagram from part (c) with the energy level diagram for an electron in a one-dimensional box of length L = 5 nm. Are the energy levels become more or less sparsely distributed in the cubic box than in the one-dimensional box? 9.39 We remarked in Impact I9.2 that the particle in a sphere is a reasonable starting point for the discussion of the electronic properties of spherical metal nanoparticles. Here, we justify eqn 9.54, which shows that the energy of an electron in a sphere is quantized. (a) The Hamiltonian for a particle free to move inside a sphere of radius R is @ = − ∇2 Show that the Schrödinger equation is separable into radial and angular components. That is, begin by writing ψ(r,θ,φ) = X(r)Y(θ,φ), where X(r) depends only on the distance of the particle away from the centre of the sphere, and Y(θ,φ) is a spherical harmonic. Then show that the Schrödinger equation can be separated into two equations, one for X, the radial equation, and the other for Y, the angular equation: − + + X(r) = EX(r) Λ2 Y = −l(l + 1)Y You may wish to consult Further information 10.1 for additional help. (c) Consider the case l = 0. Show by differentiation that the solution of the radial equation has the form X(r) = (2πR)−1/2 (e) Now go on to show that the allowed energies are given by: En = This result for the energy (which is eqn 9.54 after substituting me for m) also applies when l ≠ 0. n2 h2 8mR2 sin(nπr/R) r l(l + 1)$2 2mr2 D E F dX(r) dr 2 r d2 X(r) dr2 A B C $2 2m $ 2m Atomic structure and atomic spectra We now use the principles of quantum mechanics introduced in the preceding two chapters to describe the internal structures of atoms. We see what experimental information is available from a study of the spectrum of atomic hydrogen. Then we set up the Schrödinger equation for an electron in an atom and separate it into angular and radial parts. The wavefunctions obtained are the ‘atomic orbitals’ of hydrogenic atoms. Next, we use these hydrogenic atomic orbitals to describe the structures of many-electron atoms. In conjunction with the Pauli exclusion principle, we account for the periodicity of atomic properties. The spectra of many-electron atoms are more complicated than those of hydrogen, but the same principles apply. We see in the closing sections of the chapter how such spectra are described by using term symbols, and the origin of the finer details of their appearance. In this chapter we see how to use quantum mechanics to describe the electronicstructure of an atom, the arrangement of electrons around a nucleus. The concepts we meet are of central importance for understanding the structures and reactions of atoms and molecules, and hence have extensive chemical applications. We need to distinguish between two types of atoms. A hydrogenicatom is a one-electron atom or ion of general atomic number Z; examples of hydrogenic atoms are H, He+ , Li2+ , O7+ , and even U91+ . A many-electron atom (or polyelectronic atom) is an atom or ion with more than one electron; examples include all neutral atoms other than H. So even He, with only two electrons, is a many-electron atom. Hydrogenic atoms are important because their Schrödinger equations can be solved exactly. They also provide a set of concepts that are used to describe the structures of many-electron atoms and, as we shall see in the next chapter, the structures of molecules too. The structure and spectra of hydrogenic atoms When an electric discharge is passed through gaseous hydrogen, the H2 molecules are dissociated and the energetically excited H atoms that are produced emit light of discrete frequencies, producting a spectrum of a series of ‘lines’ (Fig. 10.1). The Swedish spectroscopist Johannes Rydberg noted (in 1890) that all of them are described by the expression # = RH − RH = 109 677 cm−1 (10.1) with n1 = 1 (the Lyman series), 2 (the Balmer series), and 3 (the Paschen series), and that in each case n2 = n1 + 1, n1 + 2, . . . . The constant RH is now called the Rydberg constant for the hydrogen atom. D F 1 n2 2 1 n1 2 A C The structure and spectra of hydrogenic atoms 10.1 The structure of hydrogenic atoms 10.2 Atomic orbitals and their energies 10.3 Spectroscopic transitions and selection rules The structures of many-electron atoms 10.4 The orbital approximation 10.5 Self-consistent field orbitals The spectra of complex atoms I10.1 Impact on astrophysics: Spectroscopy of stars 10.6 Quantum defects and ionization limits 10.7 Singlet and triplet states 10.8 Spin–orbit coupling 10.9 Term symbols and selection rules Checklist of key ideas Further reading Further information 10.1: The separation of motion Discussion questions Exercises Problems 10 10.1 THE STRUCTURE OF HYDROGENIC ATOMS 321 Self-test 10.1 Calculate the shortest wavelength line in the Paschen series. [821 nm] The form of eqn 10.1 strongly suggests that the wavenumber of each spectral line can be written as the difference of two terms, each of the form Tn = (10.2) The Ritz combination principle states that the wavenumber of any spectral line is the difference between two terms. We say that two terms T1 and T2 ‘combine’ to produce a spectral line of wavenumber # = T1 − T2 (10.3) Thus, if each spectroscopic term represents an energy hcT, the difference in energy when the atom undergoes a transition between two terms is ∆E = hcT1 − hcT2 and, according to the Bohr frequency conditions (Section 8.1d), the frequency of the radiation emitted is given by ν = cT1 − cT2. This expression rearranges into the Ritz formula when expressed in terms of wavenumbers (on division by c). The Ritz combination principle applies to all types of atoms and molecules, but only for hydrogenic atoms do the terms have the simple form (constant)/n2 . Because spectroscopic observations show that electromagnetic radiation is absorbed and emitted by atoms only at certain wavenumbers, it follows that only certain energy states of atoms are permitted. Our tasks in the first part of this chapter are to determine the origin of this energy quantization, to find the permitted energy levels, and to account for the value of RH. 10.1 The structure of hydrogenic atoms The Coulomb potential energy of an electron in a hydrogenic atom of atomic number Z (and nuclear charge Ze) is V = − (10.4) Ze2 4πε0r RH n2 2000 1000 800 600 500 400 300 200 150 120 100 /nmVisible Balmer Lyman Paschen Brackett Total Analysis l Fig. 10.1 The spectrum of atomic hydrogen. Both the observed spectrum and its resolution into overlapping series are shown. Note that the Balmer series lies in the visible region. 322 10 ATOMIC STRUCTURE AND ATOMIC SPECTRA where r is the distance of the electron from the nucleus and ε0 is the vacuum permittivity. The hamiltonian for the electron and a nucleus of mass mN is therefore @ = ÊK,electron + ÊK,nucleus + W = − ∇e 2 − ∇N 2 − (10.5) The subscripts on ∇2 indicate differentiation with respect to the electron or nuclear coordinates. (a) The separation of variables Physical intuition suggests that the full Schrödinger equation ought to separate into two equations, one for the motion of the atom as a whole through space and the other for the motion of the electron relative to the nucleus. We show in Further information 10.1 how this separation is achieved, and that the Schrödinger equation for the internal motion of the electron relative to the nucleus is − ∇2 ψ − ψ = Eψ = + (10.6) where differentiation is now with respect to the coordinates of the electron relative to the nucleus. The quantity µ is called the reduced mass. The reduced mass is very similar to the electron mass because mN, the mass of the nucleus, is much larger than the mass of an electron, so 1/µ ≈ 1/me. In all except the most precise work, the reduced mass can be replaced by me. Because the potential energy is centrosymmetric (independent of angle), we can suspect that the equation is separable into radial and angular components. Therefore, we write ψ(r,θ,φ) = R(r)Y(θ,φ) (10.7) and examine whether the Schrödinger equation can be separated into two equations, one for R and the other for Y. As shown in Further information 10.1, the equation does separate, and the equations we have to solve are Λ2 Y = −l(l +1)Y (10.8) − + Veffu = Eu u = rR (10.9) where Veff = − + (10.10) Equation 10.8 is the same as the Schrödinger equation for a particle free to move round a central point, and we considered it in Section 9.7. The solutions are the spherical harmonics (Table 9.3), and are specified by the quantum numbers l and ml. We consider them in more detail shortly. Equation 10.9 is called the radial wave equation. The radial wave equation is the description of the motion of a particle of mass µ in a one-dimensional region 0 ≤ r < ∞ where the potential energy is Veff. (b) The radial solutions We can anticipate some features of the shapes of the radial wavefunctions by analysing the form of Veff. The first term in eqn 10.10 is the Coulomb potential energy of the l(l +1)$2 2µr2 Ze2 4πε0r d2 u dr2 $2 2µ 1 mN 1 me 1 µ Ze2 4πε0r $2 2µ Ze2 4πε0r $2 2mN $2 2me 10.1 THE STRUCTURE OF HYDROGENIC ATOMS 323 electron in the field of the nucleus. The second term stems from what in classical physics would be called the centrifugal force that arises from the angular momentum of the electron around the nucleus. When l = 0, the electron has no angular momentum, and the effective potential energy is purely Coulombic and attractive at all radii (Fig. 10.2). When l ≠ 0, the centrifugal term gives a positive (repulsive) contribution to the effective potential energy. When the electron is close to the nucleus (r ≈ 0), this repulsive term, which is proportional to 1/r2 , dominates the attractive Coulombic component, which is proportional to 1/r, and the net effect is an effective repulsion of the electron from the nucleus. The two effective potential energies, the one for l = 0 and the one for l ≠ 0, are qualitatively very different close to the nucleus. However, they are similar at large distances because the centrifugal contribution tends to zero more rapidly (as 1/r2 ) than the Coulombic contribution (as 1/r). Therefore, we can expect the solutions with l = 0 and l ≠ 0 to be quite different near the nucleus but similar far away from it. We show in the Justification below that close to the nucleus the radial wavefunction is proportional to rl , and the higher the orbital angular momentum, the less likely the electron is to be found (Fig. 10.3). We also show that far from the nucleus all wavefunctions approach zero exponentially. Justification 10.1 The shape of the radial wavefunction When r is very small (close to the nucleus), u ≈ 0, so the right-hand side of eqn 10.9 is zero; we can also ignore all but the largest terms (those depending on 1/r2 ) in eqn 10.9 and write − + u ≈ 0 The solution of this equation (for r ≈ 0) is u ≈ Arl+1 + Because R = u/r, and R cannot be infinite at r = 0, we must set B = 0, and hence obtain R ≈ Arl . Far from the nucleus, when r is very large, we can ignore all terms in 1/r and eqn 10.9 becomes − t Eu where t means ‘asymptotically equal to’. Because = = r + 2 t r this equation has the form − t ER The acceptable (finite) solution of this equation (for r large) is R t e−(2µ|E|/$2 )r and the wavefunction decays exponentially towards zero as r increases. We shall not go through the technical steps of solving the radial equation for the full range of radii, and see how the form rl close to the nucleus blends into the exponentially d2 R dr2 $2 2µ d2 R dr2 dR dr d2 R dr2 d2 (rR) dr2 d2 u dr2 d2 u dr2 $2 2µ B rl l(l + 1) r2 d2 u dr2 Effectivepotentialenergy,Veff l = 0 l 0¹ Radius, r 0 Fig. 10.2 The effective potential energy of an electron in the hydrogen atom. When the electron has zero orbital angular momentum, the effective potential energy is the Coulombic potential energy. When the electron has nonzero orbital angular momentum, the centrifugal effect gives rise to a positive contribution that is very large close to the nucleus. We can expect the l = 0 and l ≠ 0 wavefunctions to be very different near the nucleus. Exploration Plot the effective potential energy against r for several nonzero values of the orbital angular momentum l. How does the location of the minimum in the effective potential energy vary with l? Radius, r Wavefunction, l = 0 1 2 3 y Fig. 10.3 Close to the nucleus, orbitals with l = 1 are proportional to r, orbitals with l = 2 are proportional to r2 , and orbitals with l = 3 are proportional to r3 . Electrons are progressively excluded from the neighbourhood of the nucleus as l increases. An orbital with l = 0 has a finite, nonzero value at the nucleus. 324 10 ATOMIC STRUCTURE AND ATOMIC SPECTRA decaying form at great distances (see Further reading). It is sufficient to know that the two limits can be matched only for integral values of a quantum number n, and that the allowed energies corresponding to the allowed solutions are En = − (10.11) with n = 1, 2, . . . Likewise, the radial wavefunctions depend on the values of both n and l (but not on ml), and all of them have the form R(r) = (polynomial in r) × (decaying exponential in r) (10.12) These functions are most simply written in terms of the dimensionless quantity ρ (rho), where ρ = a0 = (10.13) The Bohr radius, a0, has the value 52.9 pm; it is so called because the same quantity appeared in Bohr’s early model of the hydrogen atom as the radius of the electron orbit of lowest energy. Specifically, the radial wavefunctions for an electron with quantum numbers n and l are the (real) functions Rn,l(r) = Nn,lρl L2l+1 n+1(ρ)e−ρ/2 (10.14) where L is a polynomial in ρ called an associated Laguerre polynomial: it links the r ≈ 0 solutions on its left (corresponding to R ∝ ρl ) to the exponentially decaying function on its right. The notation might look fearsome, but the polynomials have quite simple forms, such as 1, ρ, and 2 − ρ (they can be picked out in Table 10.1). Specifically, we can interpret the components of this expression as follows: 1 The exponential factor ensures that the wavefunction approaches zero far from the nucleus. 4πε0$2 mee2 2Zr na0 Z2 µe4 32π2 ε2 0$2 n2 Table 10.1 Hydrogenic radial wavefunctions Orbital n l Rn,l 1s 1 0 2 3/2 e−ρ/2 2s 2 0 3/2 (2 − ρ)e−ρ/2 2p 2 1 3/2 ρe−ρ/2 3s 3 0 3/2 (6 − 6ρ + ρ2 )e−ρ/2 3p 3 1 3/2 (4 − ρ)ρe−ρ/2 3d 3 2 3/2 ρ2 e−ρ/2 ρ = (2Z/na)r with a = 4πε0$2 /µe2 . For an infinitely heavy nucleus (or one that may be assumed to be so), µ = me and a = a0, the Bohr radius. The full wavefunction is obtained by multiplying R by the appropriate Y given in Table 9.3. D E F Z a A B C 1 24301/2 D E F Z a A B C 1 4861/2 D E F Z a A B C 1 2431/2 D E F Z a A B C 1 241/2 D E F Z a A B C 1 81/2 D E F Z a A B C 10.1 THE STRUCTURE OF HYDROGENIC ATOMS 325 RZa/(/)0 3/2 0.05 0.04 0.03 0.02 0.01 0 (f) Zr a/ 0 0 22.57.5 15 Zr a/ 0 RZa/(/)0 3/2 0.1 0.05 0 –0.05 (e) 0 22.57.5 15 n l= 3, = 1 n l= 3, = 2 Fig. 10.4 The radial wavefunctions of the first few states of hydrogenic atoms of atomic number Z. Note that the orbitals with l = 0 have a nonzero and finite value at the nucleus. The horizontal scales are different in each case: orbitals with high principal quantum numbers are relatively distant from the nucleus. Exploration Use mathematical software to find the locations of the radial nodes in hydrogenic wavefunctions with n up to 3. Comment 10.1 The zero at r = 0 is not a radial node because the radial wavefunction does not pass through zero at that point (because r cannot be negative). Nodes at the nucleus are all angular nodes. 2 1.5 1 0.5 0 0 2 RZa/(/)0 3/2RZa/(/)0 3/2 –0.2 0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 0 5 10 15 (a) (b) Zr a/ 0 Zr a/ 0 1 3 n l= 1, = 0 n l= 2, = 0 RZa/(/)0 3/2 0 5 10 15 0.15 0.1 0.5 0 (d) 0 22.57.5 15 0.4 0.3 0.2 0.1 0 –0.1 RZa/(/)0 3/2 (c) Zr a/ 0 Zr a/ 0 n l= 3, = 0 n l= 2, = 1 2 Thefactorρl ensuresthat(providedl> 0)thewavefunctionvanishesatthenucleus. 3 The associated Laguerre polynomial is a function that oscillates from positive to negative values and accounts for the presence of radial nodes. Expressions for some radial wavefunctions are given in Table 10.1 and illustrated in Fig. 10.4. Illustration 10.1 Calculating a probability density To calculate the probability density at the nucleus for an electron with n = 1, l = 0, and ml = 0, we evaluate ψ at r = 0: ψ1,0,0(0,θ,φ) = R1,0(0)Y0,0(θ,φ) = 2 3/2 1/2 D F 1 4π A C D F Z a0 A C 326 10 ATOMIC STRUCTURE AND ATOMIC SPECTRA Energy 1 2 3 ¥ n Energy of widely separated stationary electron and nucleus Classically allowed energies 0 -hcRH -hcRH -hcRH 9 4 Continuum H + e+ Fig. 10.5 The energy levels of a hydrogen atom. The values are relative to an infinitely separated, stationary electron and a proton. The probability density is therefore ψ1,0,0(0,θ,φ)2 = which evaluates to 2.15 × 10−6 pm−3 when Z = 1. Self-test 10.2 Evaluate the probability density at the nucleus of the electron for an electron with n = 2, l = 0, ml = 0. [(Z/a0)3 /8π] 10.2 Atomic orbitals and their energies An atomic orbital is a one-electron wavefunction for an electron in an atom. Each hydrogenic atomic orbital is defined by three quantum numbers, designated n, l, and ml. When an electron is described by one of these wavefunctions, we say that it ‘occupies’ that orbital. We could go on to say that the electron is in the state |n,l,ml͘. For instance, an electron described by the wavefunction ψ1,0,0 and in the state |1,0,0͘ is said to occupy the orbital with n = 1, l = 0, and ml = 0. The quantum number n is called the principal quantum number; it can take the values n = 1, 2, 3, . . . and determines the energy of the electron: An electron in an orbital with quantum number n has an energy given by eqn 10.11. The two other quantum numbers, l and ml, come from the angular solutions, and specify the angular momentum of the electron around the nucleus: An electron in an orbital with quantum number l has an angular momentum of magnitude {l(l + 1)}1/2 $, with l = 0, 1, 2, . . . , n − 1. An electron in an orbital with quantum number ml has a z-component of angular momentum ml$, with ml = 0, ±1, ±2, . . . , ±l. Note how the value of the principal quantum number, n, controls the maximum value of l and l controls the range of values of ml. To define the state of an electron in a hydrogenic atom fully we need to specify not only the orbital it occupies but also its spin state. We saw in Section 9.8 that an electron possessesanintrinsicangularmomentumthatisdescribedbythetwoquantumnumbers s and ms (the analogues of l and ml). The value of s is fixed at 1 –2 for an electron, so we do not need to consider it further at this stage. However, ms may be either +1 –2 or −1 –2, and to specify the electron’s state in a hydrogenic atom we need to specify which of these values describes it. It follows that, to specify the state of an electron in a hydrogenic atom, we need to give the values of four quantum numbers, namely n, l, ml, and ms. (a) The energy levels The energy levels predicted by eqn 10.11 are depicted in Fig. 10.5. The energies, and also the separation of neighbouring levels, are proportional to Z2 , so the levels are four times as wide apart (and the ground state four times deeper in energy) in He+ (Z = 2) than in H (Z = 1). All the energies given by eqn 10.11 are negative. They refer to the bound states of the atom, in which the energy of the atom is lower than that of the infinitely separated, stationary electron and nucleus (which corresponds to the zero of energy). There are also solutions of the Schrödinger equation with positive energies. These solutions correspond to unbound states of the electron, the states to which an electron is raised when it is ejected from the atom by a high-energy collision or photon. The energies of the unbound electron are not quantized and form the continuum states of the atom. Z3 πa3 0 10.2 ATOMIC ORBITALS AND THEIR ENERGIES 327 Comment 10.2 The particle in a finite well, discussed in Section 9.3, is a primitive but useful model that gives insight into the bound and unbound states of the electron in a hydrogenic atom. Figure 9.15 shows that the energies of a particle (for example, an electron in a hydrogenic atom) are quantized when its total energy, E, is lower than its potential energy, V (the Coulomb interaction energy between the electron and the nucleus). When E > V, the particle can escape from the well (the atom is ionized) and its energies are no longer quantized, forming a continuum. 0 0.1 0.2 1/n2 80 85 90 95 100 105 110 /(10cm) 31 ˜nFig. 10.6 The plot of the data in Example 10.1 used to determine the ionization energy of an atom (in this case, of H). Exploration The initial value of n was not specified in Example 10.1. Show that the correct value can be determined by making several choices and selecting the one that leads to a straight line. Equation 10.11 is consistent with the spectroscopic result summarized by eqn 10.1, and we can identify the Rydberg constant for hydrogen (Z = 1) as hcRH = [10.15] where µH is the reduced mass for hydrogen. The Rydberg constant itself, R, is defined by the same expression except for the replacement of µH by the mass of an electron, me, corresponding to a nucleus of infinite mass: RH = R R = [10.16] Insertion of the values of the fundamental constants into the expression for RH gives almost exact agreement with the experimental value. The only discrepancies arise from the neglect of relativistic corrections (in simple terms, the increase of mass with speed), which the non-relativistic Schrödinger equation ignores. (b) Ionization energies The ionizationenergy, I, of an element is the minimum energy required to remove an electron from the ground state, the state of lowest energy, of one of its atoms. Because the ground state of hydrogen is the state with n = 1, with energy E1 = −hcRH and the atom is ionized when the electron has been excited to the level corresponding to n = ∞ (see Fig. 10.5), the energy that must be supplied is I = hcRH (10.17) The value of I is 2.179 aJ (a, for atto, is the prefix that denotes 10−18 ), which corresponds to 13.60 eV. Example 10.1 Measuring an ionization energy spectroscopically The emission spectrum of atomic hydrogen shows lines at 82 259, 97 492, 102 824, 105 292, 106 632, and 107 440 cm−1 , which correspond to transitions to the same lower state. Determine (a) the ionization energy of the lower state, (b) the value of the Rydberg constant. Method The spectroscopic determination of ionization energies depends on the determination of the series limit, the wavenumber at which the series terminates and becomes a continuum. If the upper state lies at an energy −hcRH/n2 , then, when the atom makes a transition to Elower, a photon of wavenumber # = − − is emitted. However, because I = −Elower, it follows that # = − A plot of the wavenumbers against 1/n2 should give a straight line of slope −RH and intercept I/hc. Use a computer to make a least-squares fit of the data to get a result that reflects the precision of the data. Answer The wavenumbers are plotted against 1/n2 in Fig. 10.6. The (least-squares) intercept lies at 109 679 cm−1 , so the ionization energy is 2.1788 aJ (1312.1 kJ mol−1 ). RH n2 I hc Elower hc RH n2 mee4 8ε2 0h3 c µH me µHe4 32π2 ε2 0$2 328 10 ATOMIC STRUCTURE AND ATOMIC SPECTRA Energy 1 2 3 ¥ n 1s 2s 2p 3s 3p 3d s p d f [3] [3] [5][1] [1] [1] Fig. 10.7 The energy levels of the hydrogen atom showing the subshells and (in square brackets) the numbers of orbitals in each subshell. In hydrogenic atoms, all orbitals of a given shell have the same energy. The slope is, in this instance, numerically the same, so RH = 109 679 cm−1 . A similar extrapolation procedure can be used for many-electron atoms (see Section 10.5). Self-test 10.3 The emission spectrum of atomic deuterium shows lines at 15 238, 20 571, 23 039, and 24 380 cm−1 , which correspond to transitions to the same lower state. Determine (a) the ionization energy of the lower state, (b) the ionization energy of the ground state, (c) the mass of the deuteron (by expressing the Rydberg constant in terms of the reduced mass of the electron and the deuteron, and solving for the mass of the deuteron). [(a) 328.1 kJ mol−1 , (b) 1312.4 kJ mol−1 , (c) 2.8 × 10−27 kg, a result very sensitive to RD] (c) Shells and subshells All the orbitals of a given value of n are said to form a single shell of the atom. In a hydrogenic atom, all orbitals of given n, and therefore belonging to the same shell, have the same energy. It is common to refer to successive shells by letters: n = 1 2 3 4 . . . K L M N . . . Thus, all the orbitals of the shell with n = 2 form the L shell of the atom, and so on. The orbitals with the same value of n but different values of l are said to form a subshell of a given shell. These subshells are generally referred to by letters: l = 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 . . . s p d f g h i . . . The letters then run alphabetically (j is not used). Figure 10.7 is a version of Fig. 10.5 which shows the subshells explicitly. Because l can range from 0 to n − 1, giving n values in all, it follows that there are n subshells of a shell with principal quantum number n. Thus, when n = 1, there is only one subshell, the one with l = 0. When n = 2, there are two subshells, the 2s subshell (with l = 0) and the 2p subshell (with l = 1). When n = 1 there is only one subshell, that with l = 0, and that subshell contains only one orbital, with ml = 0 (the only value of ml permitted). When n = 2, there are four orbitals, one in the s subshell with l = 0 and ml = 0, and three in the l = 1 subshell with ml = +1, 0, −1. When n = 3 there are nine orbitals (one with l = 0, three with l = 1, and five with l = 2). The organization of orbitals in the shells is summarized in Fig. 10.8. In general, the number of orbitals in a shell of principal quantum number n is n2 , so in a hydrogenic atom each energy level is n2 -fold degenerate. (d) Atomic orbitals The orbital occupied in the ground state is the one with n = 1 (and therefore with l = 0 and ml = 0, the only possible values of these quantum numbers when n = 1). From Table 10.1 we can write (for Z = 1): ψ = e−r/a0 (10.18) This wavefunction is independent of angle and has the same value at all points of constant radius; that is, the 1s orbital is spherically symmetrical. The wavefunction decays exponentially from a maximum value of 1/(πa0 3 )1/2 at the nucleus (at r = 0). It follows that the most probable point at which the electron will be found is at the nucleus itself. 1 (πa3 0)1/2 10.2 ATOMIC ORBITALS AND THEIR ENERGIES 329 We can understand the general form of the ground-state wavefunction by considering the contributions of the potential and kinetic energies to the total energy of the atom. The closer the electron is to the nucleus on average, the lower its average potential energy. This dependence suggests that the lowest potential energy should be obtained with a sharply peaked wavefunction that has a large amplitude at the nucleus and is zero everywhere else (Fig. 10.9). However, this shape implies a high kinetic energy, because such a wavefunction has a very high average curvature. The electron would have very low kinetic energy if its wavefunction had only a very low average curvature. However, such a wavefunction spreads to great distances from the nucleus and the average potential energy of the electron will be correspondingly high. The actual ground-state wavefunction is a compromise between these two extremes: the wavefunction spreads away from the nucleus (so the expectation value of the potential energy is not as low as in the first example, but nor is it very high) and has a reasonably low average curvature (so the expectation of the kinetic energy is not very low, but nor is it as high as in the first example). The energies of ns orbitals increase (become less negative; the electron becomes less tightly bound) as n increases because the average distance of the electron from the nucleus increases. By the virial theorem with b = −1 (eqn 9.35), ͗EK͘ = − 1 –2 ͗V͘ so, even though the average kinetic energy decreases as n increases, the total energy is equal to 1 –2 ͗V͘, which becomes less negative as n increases. One way of depicting the probability density of the electron is to represent |ψ |2 by the density of shading (Fig. 10.10). A simpler procedure is to show only the boundary surface, the surface that captures a high proportion (typically about 90 per cent) of the electron probability. For the 1s orbital, the boundary surface is a sphere centred on the nucleus (Fig. 10.11). Radius, r Energy Low potential energy but high kinetic energy Low kinetic energy but high potential energy Lowest total energy a b c Fig. 10.9 The balance of kinetic and potential energies that accounts for the structure of the ground state of hydrogen (and similar atoms). (a) The sharply curved but localized orbital has high mean kinetic energy, but low mean potential energy; (b) the mean kinetic energy is low, but the potential energy is not very favourable; (c) the compromise of moderate kinetic energy and moderately favourable potential energy. Fig. 10.11 The boundary surface of an s orbital, within which there is a 90 per cent probability of finding the electron. (a) 1s (b) 2s Fig. 10.10 Representations of the 1s and 2s hydrogenic atomic orbitals in terms of their electron densities (as represented by the density of shading) K nshell, = 1 L nshell, = 2 M nshell, = 3 s p d Subshellls Orbitals Shells Fig. 10.8 The organization of orbitals (white squares) into subshells (characterized by l) and shells (characterized by n). 330 10 ATOMIC STRUCTURE AND ATOMIC SPECTRA 1 2 3 4 5 6 n Zraáñ/0 0 20 40 60 s p d Fig. 10.12 The variation of the mean radius of a hydrogenic atom with the principal and orbital angular momentum quantum numbers. Note that the mean radius lies in the order d < p < s for a given value of n. The general expression for the mean radius of an orbital with quantum numbers l and n is rn,l = n2 1 + 1 –2 1 − (10.19) The variation with n and l is shown in Fig. 10.12. Note that, for a given principal quantum number, the mean radius decreases as l increases, so the average distance of an electron from the nucleus is less when it is in a 2p orbital, for instance, than when it is in a 2s orbital. Example 10.2 Calculating the mean radius of an orbital Use hydrogenic orbitals to calculate the mean radius of a 1s orbital. Method The mean radius is the expectation value ͗r͘ = Ύψ*rψ dτ = Ύr|ψ|2 dτ We therefore need to evaluate the integral using the wavefunctions given in Table 10.1 and dτ = r2 dr sin θ dθ dφ. The angular parts of the wavefunction are normalized in the sense that Ύ π 0 Ύ 2π 0 |Yl,ml |2 sin θdθ dφ = 1 The integral over r required is given in Example 8.7. Answer With the wavefunction written in the form ψ = RY, the integration is ͗r͘ = Ύ ∞ 0 Ύ π 0 Ύ 2π 0 rR2 n,l |Yl,ml |2 r2 dr sin θ dθ dφ = Ύ ∞ 0 r3 R2 n,l dr For a 1s orbital, R1,0 = 2 1/2 e−Zr/a0 Hence ͗r͘ = Ύ ∞ 0 r3 e−2Zr/a0 dr = Self-test 10.4 Evaluate the mean radius (a) of a 3s orbital by integration, and (b) of a 3p orbital by using the general formula, eqn 10.19. [(a) 27a0/2Z; (b) 25a0/2Z] All s-orbitals are spherically symmetric, but differ in the number of radial nodes. For example, the 1s, 2s, and 3s orbitals have 0, 1, and 2 radial nodes, respectively. In general, an ns orbital has n − 1 radial nodes. Self-test 10.5 (a) Use the fact that a 2s orbital has radial nodes where the polynomial factor (Table 10.1) is equal to zero, and locate the radial node at 2a0/Z (see Fig. 10.4). (b) Similarly, locate the two nodes of a 3s orbital. [(a) 2a0/Z; (b)1.90a0/Z and 7.10a0/Z] 3a0 2Z 4Z a3 0 D F Z a3 0 A C a0 Z 5 6 7 D F l(l + 1) n2 A C 1 2 3 10.2 ATOMIC ORBITALS AND THEIR ENERGIES 331 (e) Radial distribution functions The wavefunction tells us, through the value of |ψ |2 , the probability of finding an electron in any region. We can imagine a probe with a volume dτ and sensitive to electrons, and which we can move around near the nucleus of a hydrogen atom. Because the probability density in the ground state of the atom is |ψ|2 ∝ e−2Zr/a0 , the reading from the detector decreases exponentially as the probe is moved out along any radius but is constant if the probe is moved on a circle of constant radius (Fig. 10.13). Now consider the probability of finding the electron anywhere between the two walls of a spherical shell of thickness dr at a radius r. The sensitive volume of the probe is now the volume of the shell (Fig. 10.14), which is 4πr2 dr (the product of its surface area, 4πr2 , and its thickness, dr). The probability that the electron will be found between the inner and outer surfaces of this shell is the probability density at the radius r multiplied by the volume of the probe, or |ψ|2 × 4πr2 dr. This expression has the form P(r)dr, where P(r) = 4πr2 ψ2 (10.20) The more general expression, which also applies to orbitals that are not spherically symmetrical, is P(r) = r2 R(r)2 (10.21) where R(r) is the radial wavefunction for the orbital in question. Justification 10.2 The general form of the radial distribution function The probability of finding an electron in a volume element dτ when its wavefunction is ψ = RY is |RY |2 dτ with dτ = r2 dr sin θ dθdφ. The total probability of finding the electron at any angle at a constant radius is the integral of this probability over the surface of a sphere of radius r, and is written P(r)dr; so ψ2 dτ P(r)dr = Ύ π 0 Ύ 2π 0 R(r)2 |Y(θ,φ)|2 r2 dr sinθdθdφ 1 = r2 R(r)2 dr Ύ π 0 Ύ 2π 0 |Y(θ,φ)|2 sinθdθdφ = r2 R(r)2 dr The last equality follows from the fact that the spherical harmonics are normalized to 1 (see Example 10.2). It follows that P(r) = r2 R(r)2 , as stated in the text. The radial distribution function, P(r), is a probability density in the sense that, when it is multiplied by dr, it gives the probability of finding the electron anywhere between the two walls of a spherical shell of thickness dr at the radius r. For a 1s orbital, P(r) = r2 e−2Zr/a0 (10.22) Let’s interpret this expression: 1 Because r2 = 0 at the nucleus, at the nucleus P(0) = 0. 2 As r → ∞, P(r) → 0 on account of the exponential term. 3 The increase in r2 and the decrease in the exponential factor means that P passes through a maximum at an intermediate radius (see Fig. 10.14). 4Z3 a3 0 5 4 4 4 6 4 4 4 7 5 4 6 4 7 5 4 6 4 7 *d Radius r yyt Fig. 10.13 A constant-volume electronsensitive detector (the small cube) gives its greatest reading at the nucleus, and a smaller reading elsewhere. The same reading is obtained anywhere on a circle of given radius: the s orbital is spherically symmetrical. 0 0 2 4 r a/ 0 PZa/(/)0 3 0.6 0.4 0.2 Fig. 10.14 The radial distribution function P gives the probability that the electron will be found anywhere in a shell of radius r. For a 1s electron in hydrogen, P is a maximum when r is equal to the Bohr radius a0. The value of P is equivalent to the reading that a detector shaped like a spherical shell would give as its radius is varied. 332 10 ATOMIC STRUCTURE AND ATOMIC SPECTRA The maximum of P(r), which can be found by differentiation, marks the most probable radius at which the electron will be found, and for a 1s orbital in hydrogen occurs at r = a0, the Bohr radius. When we carry through the same calculation for the radial distribution function of the 2s orbital in hydrogen, we find that the most probable radius is 5.2a0 = 275 pm. This larger value reflects the expansion of the atom as its energy increases. Example 10.3 Calculating the most probable radius Calculate the most probable radius, r*, at which an electron will be found when it occupies a 1s orbital of a hydrogenic atom of atomic number Z, and tabulate the values for the one-electron species from H to Ne9+ . Method We find the radius at which the radial distribution function of the hydrogenic 1s orbital has a maximum value by solving dP/dr = 0. If there are several maxima, then we choose the one corresponding to the greatest amplitude (the outermost one). Answer The radial distribution function is given in eqn 10.22. It follows that = 2r − e−2Zr/a0 This function is zero where the term in parentheses is zero, which is at r* = Then, with a0 = 52.9 pm, the radial node lies at H He+ Li2+ Be3+ B4+ C5+ N6+ O7+ F8+ Ne9+ r*/pm 52.9 26.5 17.6 13.2 10.6 8.82 7.56 6.61 5.88 5.29 Notice how the 1s orbital is drawn towards the nucleus as the nuclear charge increases. At uranium the most probable radius is only 0.58 pm, almost 100 times closer than for hydrogen. (On a scale where r* = 10 cm for H, r* = 1 mm for U.) The electron then experiences strong accelerations and relativistic effects are important. Self-test 10.6 Find the most probable distance of a 2s electron from the nucleus in a hydrogenic atom. [(3 + 51/2 )a0/Z] (f) p Orbitals The three 2p orbitals are distinguished by the three different values that ml can take when l = 1. Because the quantum number ml tells us the orbital angular momentum around an axis, these different values of ml denote orbitals in which the electron has different orbital angular momenta around an arbitrary z-axis but the same magnitude of that momentum (because l is the same for all three). The orbital with ml = 0, for instance, has zero angular momentum around the z-axis. Its angular variation is proportional to cos θ, so the probability density, which is proportional to cos2 θ, has its maximum value on either side of the nucleus along the z-axis (at θ = 0 and 180°). The wavefunction of a 2p-orbital with ml = 0 is a0 Z D F 2Zr2 a0 A C 4Z3 a3 0 dP dr 10.2 ATOMIC ORBITALS AND THEIR ENERGIES 333 ψp0 = R2,1(r)Y1,0(θ,φ) = 5/2 r cos θe−Zr/2a0 = r cos θf(r) where f(r) is a function only of r. Because in spherical polar coordinates z = r cos θ, this wavefunction may also be written ψpz = zf(r) (10.23) All p orbitals with ml = 0 have wavefunctions of this form regardless of the value of n. This way of writing the orbital is the origin of the name ‘pz orbital’: its boundary surface is shown in Fig. 10.15. The wavefunction is zero everywhere in the xy-plane, where z = 0, so the xy-plane is a nodal plane of the orbital: the wavefunction changes sign on going from one side of the plane to the other. The wavefunctions of 2p orbitals with ml = ±1 have the following form: ψp±1 = R2,1(r)Y1,±1(θ,φ) = , 5/2 re−Zr/2a0 sin θe±iφ = , r sin θe±iφ f(r) We saw in Chapter 8 that a moving particle can be described by a complex wavefunction. In the present case, the functions correspond to non-zero angular momentum about the z-axis: e+iφ corresponds to clockwise rotation when viewed from below, and e−iφ corresponds to counter-clockwise rotation (from the same viewpoint). They have zero amplitude where θ = 0 and 180° (along the z-axis) and maximum amplitude at 90°, which is in the xy-plane. To draw the functions it is usual to represent them as standing waves. To do so, we take the real linear combinations ψpx = − (p+1 − p−1) = r sin θ cos φ f(r) = xf(r) (10.24) ψpy = (p+1 + p−1) = r sin θ sin φ f(r) = yf(r) These linear combinations are indeed standing waves with no net orbital angular momentum around the z-axis, as they are superpositions of states with equal and opposite values of ml. The px orbital has the same shape as a pz orbital, but it is directed i 21/2 1 21/2 1 21/2 D F Z a0 A C 1 8π1/2 D F Z a0 A C 1 4(2π)1/2 x y z pxpz py + - + + - Fig. 10.15 The boundary surfaces of p orbitals. A nodal plane passes through the nucleus and separates the two lobes of each orbital. The dark and light areas denote regions of opposite sign of the wavefunction. Exploration Use mathematical software to plot the boundary surfaces of the real parts of the spherical harmonics Y1,ml (θ,φ). The resulting plots are not strictly the p orbital boundary surfaces, but sufficiently close to be reasonable representations of the shapes of hydrogenic orbitals. 334 10 ATOMIC STRUCTURE AND ATOMIC SPECTRA along the x-axis (see Fig. 10.15); the py orbital is similarly directed along the y-axis. The wavefunction of any p orbital of a given shell can be written as a product of x, y, or z and the same radial function (which depends on the value of n). Justification 10.3 The linear combination of degenerate wavefunctions We justify here the step of taking linear combinations of degenerate orbitals when we want to indicate a particular point. The freedom to do so rests on the fact that, whenever two or more wavefunctions correspond to the same energy, any linear combination of them is an equally valid solution of the Schrödinger equation. Suppose ψ1 and ψ2 are both solutions of the Schrödinger equation with energy E; then we know that Hψ1 = Eψ1 Hψ2 = Eψ2 Now consider the linear combination ψ = c1ψ1 + c2ψ2 where c1 and c2 are arbitrary coefficients. Then it follows that Hψ = H(c1ψ1 + c2ψ2) = c1Hψ1 + c2Hψ2 = c1Eψ1 + c2Eψ2 = Eψ Hence, the linear combination is also a solution corresponding to the same energy E. (g) d Orbitals When n = 3, l can be 0, 1, or 2. As a result, this shell consists of one 3s orbital, three 3p orbitals, and five 3d orbitals. The five d orbitals have ml = +2, +1, 0, −1, −2 and correspond to five different angular momenta around the z-axis (but the same magnitude of angular momentum, because l = 2 in each case). As for the p orbitals, d orbitals with opposite values of ml (and hence opposite senses of motion around the z-axis) may be combined in pairs to give real standing waves, and the boundary surfaces of the resulting shapes are shown in Fig. 10.16. The real combinations have the following forms: dxy = xyf(r) dyz = yzf(r) dzx = zxf(r) dx2 −y2 = 1 –2(x2 − y2 )f(r) dz2 = (1 –2√3)(3z2 − r2 )f(r) (10.25) z x y dz2 dx y2 2- dxy dyz dzx Fig. 10.16 The boundary surfaces of d orbitals. Two nodal planes in each orbital intersect at the nucleus and separate the lobes of each orbital. The dark and light areas denote regions of opposite sign of the wavefunction. Exploration To gain insight into the shapes of the f orbitals, use mathematical software to plot the boundary surfaces of the spherical harmonics Y3,ml (θ,φ). 10.3 SPECTROSCOPIC TRANSITIONS AND SELECTION RULES 335 10.3 Spectroscopic transitions and selection rules The energies of the hydrogenic atoms are given by eqn 10.11. When the electron undergoes a transition, a change of state, from an orbital with quantum numbers n1, l1, ml1 to another (lower energy) orbital with quantum numbers n2, l2, ml2, it undergoes a change of energy ∆E and discards the excess energy as a photon of electromagnetic radiation with a frequency ν given by the Bohr frequency condition (eqn 8.10). It is tempting to think that all possible transitions are permissible, and that a spectrum arises from the transition of an electron from any initial orbital to any other orbital. However, this is not so, because a photon has an intrinsic spin angular momentum corresponding to s = 1 (Section 9.8). The change in angular momentum of the electron must compensate for the angular momentum carried away by the photon. Thus, an electron in a d orbital (l = 2) cannot make a transition into an s orbital (l = 0) because the photon cannot carry away enough angular momentum. Similarly, an s electron cannot make a transition to another s orbital, because there would then be no change in the electron’s angular momentum to make up for the angular momentum carried away by the photon. It follows that some spectroscopic transitions are allowed, meaning that they can occur, whereas others are forbidden, meaning that they cannot occur. A selection rule is a statement about which transitions are allowed. They are derived (for atoms) by identifying the transitions that conserve angular momentum when a photon is emitted or absorbed. The selection rules for hydrogenic atoms are ∆l = ±1 ∆ml = 0, ±1 (10.26) The principal quantum number n can change by any amount consistent with the ∆l for the transition, because it does not relate directly to the angular momentum. Justification 10.4 The identification of selection rules We saw in Section 9.10 that the rate of transition between two states is proportional to the square of the transition dipole moment, µfi, between the initial and final states, where (using the notation introduced in Further information 9.1) µfi = ͗f|µ|i͘ [10.27] and µ is the electric dipole moment operator. For a one-electron atom µ is multiplication by −er with components µx = −ex, µy = −ey, and µz = −ez. If the transition dipole moment is zero, the transition is forbidden; the transition is allowed if the transition moment is non-zero. Physically, the transition dipole moment is a measure ofthedipolar‘kick’thattheelectrongivestoorreceivesfromtheelectromagneticfield. To evaluate a transition dipole moment, we consider each component in turn. For example, for the z-component, µz,fi = −e͗f|z|i͘ = −eΎψf*zψi dτ (10.28) To evaluate the integral, we note from Table 9.3 that z = (4π/3)1/2 rY1,0, so ψf z ψi dτ Ύψf*zψidτ = Ύ ∞ 0 Ύ π 0 Ύ 2π 0 Rnf,lf Y*lf,ml,f 1/2 rY1,0 Rni,li Yli,ml,i r2 dr sin θdθdφ This multiple integral is the product of three factors, an integral over r and two integrals over the angles, so the factors on the right can be grouped as follows: Ύψf*zψidτ = 1/2 Ύ ∞ 0 Rnf,lf rRni,li r2 drΎ π 0 Ύ 2π 0 Y*lf,ml,f Y1,0Yli,ml,i sin θdθdφ D E F 4π 3 A B C D E F 4π 3 A B C 5 4 4 6 4 4 7 5 4 6 4 7 5 4 6 4 7 5 4 6 4 7 336 10 ATOMIC STRUCTURE AND ATOMIC SPECTRA s p d Lyman Balmer Paschen 20 571 cm (H )-1 b 15 328 cm (H )-1 a 23 039 cm (H )-1 g 24 380 cm (H ) -1 d 102 824 cm-1 97 492 cm-1 82 259 cm-1 Fig. 10.17 A Grotrian diagram that summarizes the appearance and analysis of the spectrum of atomic hydrogen. The thicker the line, the more intense the transition. It follows from the properties of the spherical harmonics (Comment 9.6) that the integral Ύ π 0 Ύ 2π 0 Y*lf,mlf Y1,mYli,mli sin θdθdφ is zero unless lf = li ± 1 and ml,f = ml,i + m. Because m = 0 in the present case, the angular integral, and hence the z-component of the transition dipole moment, is zero unless ∆l = ±1 and ∆ml = 0, which is a part of the set of selection rules. The same procedure, but considering the x- and y-components, results in the complete set of rules. Illustration 10.2 Applying selection rules To identify the orbitals to which a 4d electron may make radiative transitions, we first identify the value of l and then apply the selection rule for this quantum number. Because l = 2, the final orbital must have l = 1 or 3. Thus, an electron may make a transition from a 4d orbital to any np orbital (subject to ∆ml = 0, ±1) and to any nf orbital (subject to the same rule). However, it cannot undergo a transition to any other orbital, so a transition to any ns orbital or to another nd orbital is forbidden. Self-test 10.7 To what orbitals may a 4s electron make electric-dipole allowed radiative transitions? [to np orbitals only] The selection rules and the atomic energy levels jointly account for the structure of a Grotrian diagram (Fig. 10.17), which summarizes the energies of the states and the transitions between them. The thicknesses of the transition lines in the diagram denote their relative intensities in the spectrum; we see how to determine transition intensities in Section 13.2. The structures of many-electron atoms The Schrödinger equation for a many-electron atom is highly complicated because all the electrons interact with one another. Even for a helium atom, with its two electrons, no analytical expression for the orbitals and energies can be given, and we are forced to make approximations. We shall adopt a simple approach based on what we already know about the structure of hydrogenic atoms. Later we shall see the kind of numerical computations that are currently used to obtain accurate wavefunctions and energies. 10.4 The orbital approximation The wavefunction of a many-electron atom is a very complicated function of the coordinates of all the electrons, and we should write it ψ(r1,r2, . . . ), where ri is the vector from the nucleus to electron i. However, in the orbital approximation we suppose that a reasonable first approximation to this exact wavefunction is obtained by thinking of each electron as occupying its ‘own’ orbital, and write ψ(r1,r2, . . . ) = ψ(r1)ψ(r2) . . . (10.29) 10.4 THE ORBITAL APPROXIMATION 337 We can think of the individual orbitals as resembling the hydrogenic orbitals, but corresponding to nuclear charges modified by the presence of all the other electrons in the atom. This description is only approximate, but it is a useful model for discussing the chemical properties of atoms, and is the starting point for more sophisticated descriptions of atomic structure. Justification 10.5 The orbital approximation The orbital approximation would be exact if there were no interactions between electrons. To demonstrate the validity of this remark, we need to consider a system in which the hamiltonian for the energy is the sum of two contributions, one for electron 1 and the other for electron 2: @ = @1 + @2 In an actual atom (such as helium atom), there is an additional term corresponding to the interaction of the two electrons, but we are ignoring that term. We shall now show that if ψ(r1) is an eigenfunction of @1 with energy E1, and ψ(r2) is an eigenfunction of @2 with energy E2, then the product ψ(r1,r2) = ψ(r1)ψ(r2) is an eigenfunction of the combined hamiltonian @. To do so we write @ψ(r1,r2) = (@1 + @2)ψ(r1)ψ(r2) = @1ψ(r1)ψ(r2) + ψ(r1)@2ψ(r2) = E1ψ(r1)ψ(r2) + ψ(r1)E2ψ(r2) = (E1 + E2)ψ(r1)ψ(r2) = Eψ(r1,r2) where E = E1 + E2. This is the result we need to prove. However, if the electrons interact (as they do in fact), then the proof fails. (a) The helium atom The orbital approximation allows us to express the electronic structure of an atom by reporting its configuration, the list of occupied orbitals (usually, but not necessarily, in its ground state). Thus, as the ground state of a hydrogenic atom consists of the single electron in a 1s orbital, we report its configuration as 1s1 . The He atom has two electrons. We can imagine forming the atom by adding the electrons in succession to the orbitals of the bare nucleus (of charge 2e). The first electron occupies a 1s hydrogenic orbital, but because Z = 2 that orbital is more compact than in H itself. The second electron joins the first in the 1s orbital, so the electron configuration of the ground state of He is 1s2 . (b) The Pauli principle Lithium, with Z = 3, has three electrons. The first two occupy a 1s orbital drawn even more closely than in He around the more highly charged nucleus. The third electron, however, does not join the first two in the 1s orbital because that configuration is forbidden by the Pauli exclusion principle: No more than two electrons may occupy any given orbital, and if two do occupy one orbital, then their spins must be paired. Electrons with paired spins, denoted ↑↓, have zero net spin angular momentum because the spin of one electron is cancelled by the spin of the other. Specifically, one electron has ms = +1 –2, the other has ms = −1 –2 and they are orientated on their respective cones so that the resultant spin is zero (Fig. 10.18). The exclusion principle is the key to the structure of complex atoms, to chemical periodicity, and to molecular structure. It was proposed by Wolfgang Pauli in 1924 when he was trying to account for the ms = + ms = - 1 2- 1 2Fig. 10.18 Electrons with paired spins have zero resultant spin angular momentum. They can be represented by two vectors that lie at an indeterminate position on the cones shown here, but wherever one lies on its cone, the other points in the opposite direction; their resultant is zero. 338 10 ATOMIC STRUCTURE AND ATOMIC SPECTRA absence of some lines in the spectrum of helium. Later he was able to derive a very general form of the principle from theoretical considerations. The Pauli exclusion principle in fact applies to any pair of identical fermions (particles with half integral spin). Thus it applies to protons, neutrons, and 13 C nuclei (all of which have spin 1 –2) and to 35 Cl nuclei (which have spin 3 –2). It does not apply to identical bosons (particles with integral spin), which include photons (spin 1), 12 C nuclei (spin 0). Any number of identical bosons may occupy the same state (that is, be described by the same wavefunction). The Pauli exclusion principle is a special case of a general statement called the Pauli principle: When the labels of any two identical fermions are exchanged, the total wavefunction changes sign; when the labels of any two identical bosons are exchanged, the total wavefunction retains the same sign. By ‘total wavefunction’ is meant the entire wavefunction, including the spin of the particles. To see that the Pauli principle implies the Pauli exclusion principle, we consider the wavefunction for two electrons ψ(1,2). The Pauli principle implies that it is a fact of nature (which has its roots in the theory of relativity) that the wavefunction must change sign if we interchange the labels 1 and 2 wherever they occur in the function: ψ(2,1) = −ψ(1,2) (10.30) Suppose the two electrons in an atom occupy an orbital ψ, then in the orbital approximation the overall wavefunction is ψ(1)ψ(2). To apply the Pauli principle, we must deal with the total wavefunction, the wavefunction including spin. There are several possibilities for two spins: both α, denoted α(1)α(2), both β, denoted β(1)β(2), and one α the other β, denoted either α(1)β(2) or α(2)β(1). Because we cannot tell which electron is α and which is β, in the last case it is appropriate to express the spin states as the (normalized) linear combinations σ+(1,2) = (1/21/2 ){α(1)β(2) + β(1)α(2)} σ−(1,2) = (1/21/2 ){α(1)β(2) − β(1)α(2)} (10.31) because these combinations allow one spin to be α and the other β with equal probability. The total wavefunction of the system is therefore the product of the orbital part and one of the four spin states: ψ(1)ψ(2)α(1)α(2) ψ(1)ψ(2)β(1)β(2) ψ(1)ψ(2)σ+(1,2) ψ(1)ψ(2)σ−(1,2) The Pauli principle says that for a wavefunction to be acceptable (for electrons), it must change sign when the electrons are exchanged. In each case, exchanging the labels 1 and 2 converts the factor ψ(1)ψ(2) into ψ(2)ψ(1), which is the same, because the order of multiplying the functions does not change the value of the product. The same is true of α(1)α(2) and β(1)β(2). Therefore, the first two overall products are not allowed, because they do not change sign. The combination σ+(1,2) changes to σ+(2,1) = (1/21/2 ){α(2)β(1) + β(2)α(1)} = σ+(1,2) because it is simply the original function written in a different order. The third overall product is therefore also disallowed. Finally, consider σ−(1,2): σ−(2,1) = (1/21/2 ){α(2)β(1) − β(2)α(1)} = −(1/21/2 ){α(1)β(2) − β(1)α(2)} = −σ−(1,2) This combination does change sign (it is ‘antisymmetric’). The product ψ(1)ψ(2) σ−(1,2) also changes sign under particle exchange, and therefore it is acceptable. Comment 10.3 A stronger justification for taking linear combinations in eqn 10.31 is that they correspond to eigenfunctions of the total spin operators S2 and Sz, with MS = 0 and, respectively, S = 1 and 0. See Section 10.7. 10.4 THE ORBITAL APPROXIMATION 339 Now we see that only one of the four possible states is allowed by the Pauli principle, and the one that survives has paired α and β spins. This is the content of the Pauli exclusion principle. The exclusion principle is irrelevant when the orbitals occupied by the electrons are different, and both electrons may then have (but need not have) the same spin state. Nevertheless, even then the overall wavefunction must still be antisymmetric overall, and must still satisfy the Pauli principle itself. A final point in this connection is that the acceptable product wavefunction ψ(1)ψ(2)σ−(1,2) can be expressed as a determinant: ψ(1)α(1) ψ(2)α(2) ψ(1)β(1) ψ(2)β(2) = {ψ(1)α(1)ψ(2)β(2) − ψ(2)α(2)ψ(1)β(1)} = ψ(1)ψ(2)σ−(1,2) Any acceptable wavefunction for a closed-shell species can be expressed as a Slater determinant, as such determinants are known. In general, for N electrons in orbitals ψa, ψb, . . . ψa(1)α(1) ψa(2)α(2) ψa(3)α(3) . . . ψa(N)α(N) ψa(1)β(1) ψa(2)β(2) ψa(3)β(3) . . . ψa(N)β(N) ψ(1,2, . . . , N) = ψb(1)α(1) ψb(2)α(2) ψb(3)α(3) . . . ψb(N)α(N) Ӈ Ӈ Ӈ Ӈ Ӈ ψz(1)β(1) ψz(2)β(2) ψz(3)β(3) . . . ψz(N)β(N) [10.32] Writing a many-electron wavefunction in this way ensures that it is antisymmetric under the interchange of any pair of electrons, as is explored in Problem 10.23. Now we can return to lithium. In Li (Z = 3), the third electron cannot enter the 1s orbital because that orbital is already full: we say the K shell is complete and that the two electrons form a closed shell. Because a similar closed shell is characteristic of the He atom, we denote it [He]. The third electron is excluded from the K shell and must occupy the next available orbital, which is one with n = 2 and hence belonging to the L shell. However, we now have to decide whether the next available orbital is the 2s orbital or a 2p orbital, and therefore whether the lowest energy configuration of the atom is [He]2s1 or [He]2p1 . (c) Penetration and shielding Unlike in hydrogenic atoms, the 2s and 2p orbitals (and, in general, all subshells of a given shell) are not degenerate in many-electron atoms. As will be familiar from introductory chemistry, an electron in a many-electron atom experiences a Coulombic repulsion from all the other electrons present. If it is at a distance r from the nucleus, it experiences an average repulsion that can be represented by a point negative charge located at the nucleus and equal in magnitude to the total charge of the electrons within a sphere of radius r (Fig. 10.19). The effect of this point negative charge, when averaged over all the locations of the electron, is to reduce the full charge of the nucleus from Ze to Zeffe, the effective nuclear charge. In everyday parlance, Zeff itself is commonly referred to as the ‘effective nuclear charge’. We say that the electron experiences a shielded nuclear charge, and the difference between Z and Zeff is called the shielding constant, σ: Zeff = Z − σ [10.33] The electrons do not actually ‘block’ the full Coulombic attraction of the nucleus: the shielding constant is simply a way of expressing the net outcome of the nuclear 1 (N!)1/2 1 21/2 1 21/2 Fig. 10.19 An electron at a distance r from the nucleus experiences a Coulombic repulsion from all the electrons within a sphere of radius r and which is equivalent to a point negative charge located on the nucleus. The negative charge reduces the effective nuclear charge of the nucleus from Ze to Zeffe. r No net effect of these electrons Net effect equivalent to a point charge at the centre 340 10 ATOMIC STRUCTURE AND ATOMIC SPECTRA attraction and the electronic repulsions in terms of a single equivalent charge at the centre of the atom. The shielding constant is different for s and p electrons because they have different radial distributions (Fig. 10.20). An s electron has a greater penetration through inner shells than a p electron, in the sense that it is more likely to be found close to the nucleus than a p electron of the same shell (the wavefunction of a p orbital, remember, is zero at the nucleus). Because only electrons inside the sphere defined by the location of the electron (in effect, the core electrons) contribute to shielding, an s electron experiences less shielding than a p electron. Consequently, by the combined effects of penetration and shielding, an s electron is more tightly bound than a p electron of the same shell. Similarly, a d electron penetrates less than a p electron of the same shell (recall that the wavefunction of a d orbital varies as r2 close to the nucleus, whereas a p orbital varies as r), and therefore experiences more shielding. Shielding constants for different types of electrons in atoms have been calculated from their wavefunctions obtained by numerical solution of the Schrödinger equation for the atom (Table 10.2). We see that, in general, valence-shell s electrons do experience higher effective nuclear charges than p electrons, although there are some discrepancies. We return to this point shortly. The consequence of penetration and shielding is that the energies of subshells of a shell in a many-electron atom in general lie in the order s < p < d < f The individual orbitals of a given subshell remain degenerate because they all have the same radial characteristics and so experience the same effective nuclear charge. We can now complete the Li story. Because the shell with n = 2 consists of two nondegenerate subshells, with the 2s orbital lower in energy than the three 2p orbitals, the third electron occupies the 2s orbital. This occupation results in the ground-state configuration 1s2 2s1 , with the central nucleus surrounded by a complete helium-like shell of two 1s electrons, and around that a more diffuse 2s electron. The electrons in the outermost shell of an atom in its ground state are called the valence electrons because they are largely responsible for the chemical bonds that the atom forms. Thus, the valence electron in Li is a 2s electron and its other two electrons belong to its core. (d) The building-up principle The extension of this argument is called the building-up principle, or the Aufbau principle, from the German word for building up, which will be familiar from introductory courses. In brief, we imagine the bare nucleus of atomic number Z, and then feed into the orbitals Z electrons in succession. The order of occupation is 1s 2s 2p 3s 3p 4s 3d 4p 5s 4d 5p 6s and each orbital may accommodate up to two electrons. As an example, consider the carbon atom, for which Z = 6 and there are six electrons to accommodate. Two electrons enter and fill the 1s orbital, two enter and fill the 2s orbital, leaving two electrons to occupy the orbitals of the 2p subshell. Hence the ground-state configuration of C is 1s2 2s2 2p2 , or more succinctly [He]2s2 2p2 , with [He] the helium-like 1s2 core. However, we can be more precise: we can expect the last two electrons to occupy different 2p orbitals because they will then be further apart on average and repel each other less than if they were in the same orbital. Thus, one electron can be thought of as occupying the 2px orbital and the other the 2py orbital (the x, y, z designation is arbitrary, and it would be equally valid to use the complex forms of these orbitals), and the lowest energy configuration of the atom is [He]2s2 2p1 x2p1 y. The same rule 0 4 8 12 16 3p 3s Zr/a0 Radialdistributionfunction,P Synoptic table 10.2* Effective nuclear charge, Zeff = Z – σ Element Z Orbital Zeff He 2 1s 1.6875 C 6 1s 5.6727 2s 3.2166 2p 3.1358 * More values are given in the Data section. Fig. 10.20 An electron in an s orbital (here a 3s orbital) is more likely to be found close to the nucleus than an electron in a p orbital of the same shell (note the closeness of the innermost peak of the 3s orbital to the nucleus at r = 0). Hence an s electron experiences less shielding and is more tightly bound than a p electron. Exploration Calculate and plot the graphs given above for n = 4. 10.4 THE ORBITAL APPROXIMATION 341 applies whenever degenerate orbitals of a subshell are available for occupation. Thus, another rule of the building-up principle is: Electrons occupy different orbitals of a given subshell before doubly occupying any one of them. For instance, nitrogen (Z = 7) has the configuration [He]2s2 2p1 x2p1 y2p1 z, and only when we get to oxygen (Z = 8) is a 2p orbital doubly occupied, giving [He]2s2 2p2 x2p1 y2p1 z. When electrons occupy orbitals singly we invoke Hund’smaximummultiplicityrule: An atom in its ground state adopts a configuration with the greatest number of unpaired electrons. The explanation of Hund’s rule is subtle, but it reflects the quantum mechanical property of spin correlation, that electrons with parallel spins behave as if they have a tendency to stay well apart, and hence repel each other less. In essence, the effect of spin correlation is to allow the atom to shrink slightly, so the electron–nucleus interaction is improved when the spins are parallel. We can now conclude that, in the ground state of the carbon atom, the two 2p electrons have the same spin, that all three 2p electrons in the N atoms have the same spin, and that the two 2p electrons in different orbitals in the O atom have the same spin (the two in the 2px orbital are necessarily paired). Justification 10.6 Spin correlation Suppose electron 1 is described by a wavefunction ψa(r1) and electron 2 is described by a wavefunction ψb(r2); then, in the orbital approximation, the joint wavefunction of the electrons is the product ψ = ψa(r1)ψb(r2). However, this wavefunction is not acceptable, because it suggests that we know which electron is in which orbital, whereas we cannot keep track of electrons. According to quantum mechanics, the correct description is either of the two following wavefunctions: ψ± = (1/21/2 ){ψa(r1)ψb(r2) ± ψb(r1)ψa(r2)} According to the Pauli principle, because ψ+ is symmetrical under particle interchange, it must be multiplied by an antisymmetric spin function (the one denoted σ−). That combination corresponds to a spin-paired state. Conversely, ψ− is antisymmetric, so it must be multiplied by one of the three symmetric spin states. These three symmetric states correspond to electrons with parallel spins (see Section 10.7 for an explanation). Now consider the values of the two combinations when one electron approaches another, and r1 = r2. We see that ψ− vanishes, which means that there is zero probability of finding the two electrons at the same point in space when they have parallel spins. The other combination does not vanish when the two electrons are at the same point in space. Because the two electrons have different relative spatial distributions depending on whether their spins are parallel or not, it follows that their Coulombic interaction is different, and hence that the two states have different energies. Neon, with Z = 10, has the configuration [He]2s2 2p6 , which completes the L shell. This closed-shell configuration is denoted [Ne], and acts as a core for subsequent elements. The next electron must enter the 3s orbital and begin a new shell, so an Na atom, with Z = 11, has the configuration [Ne]3s1 . Like lithium with the configuration [He]2s1 , sodium has a single s electron outside a complete core. This analysis has brought us to the origin of chemical periodicity. The L shell is completed by eight electrons, so the element with Z = 3 (Li) should have similar properties to the element with Z = 11 (Na). Likewise, Be (Z = 4) should be similar to Z = 12 (Mg), and so on, up to the noble gases He (Z = 2), Ne (Z = 10), and Ar (Z = 18). 342 10 ATOMIC STRUCTURE AND ATOMIC SPECTRA Ten electrons can be accommodated in the five 3d orbitals, which accounts for the electron configurations of scandium to zinc. Calculations of the type discussed in Section 10.5 show that for these atoms the energies of the 3d orbitals are always lower than the energy of the 4s orbital. However, spectroscopic results show that Sc has the configuration [Ar]3d1 4s2 , instead of [Ar]3d3 or [Ar]3d2 4s1 . To understand this observation, we have to consider the nature of electron–electron repulsions in 3d and 4s orbitals. The most probable distance of a 3d electron from the nucleus is less than that for a 4s electron, so two 3d electrons repel each other more strongly than two 4s electrons. As a result, Sc has the configuration [Ar]3d1 4s2 rather than the two alternatives, for then the strong electron–electron repulsions in the 3d orbitals are minimized. The total energy of the atom is least despite the cost of allowing electrons to populate the high energy 4s orbital (Fig. 10.21). The effect just described is generally true for scandium through zinc, so their electron configurations are of the form [Ar]3dn 4s2 , where n = 1 for scandium and n = 10 for zinc. Two notable exceptions, which are observed experimentally, are Cr, with electron configuration [Ar]3d5 4s1 , and Cu, with electron configuration [Ar]3d10 4s1 (see Further reading for a discussion of the theoretical basis for these exceptions). At gallium, the building-up principle is used in the same way as in preceding periods. Now the 4s and 4p subshells constitute the valence shell, and the period terminates with krypton. Because 18 electrons have intervened since argon, this period is the first ‘long period’ of the periodic table. The existence of the d-block elements (the ‘transition metals’) reflects the stepwise occupation of the 3d orbitals, and the subtle shades of energy differences and effects of electron–electron repulsion along this series gives rise to the rich complexity of inorganic d-metal chemistry. A similar intrusion of the f orbitals in Periods 6 and 7 accounts for the existence of the f block of the periodic table (the lanthanoids and actinoids). We derive the configurations of cations of elements in the s, p, and d blocks of the periodic table by removing electrons from the ground-state configuration of the neutral atom in a specific order. First, we remove valence p electrons, then valence s electrons, and then as many d electrons as are necessary to achieve the specified charge. For instance, because the configuration of V is [Ar]3d3 4s2 , the V2+ cation has the configuration [Ar]3d3 . It is reasonable that we remove the more energetic 4s electrons in order to form the cation, but it is not obvious why the [Ar]3d3 configuration is preferred in V2+ over the [Ar]3d1 4s2 configuration, which is found in the isoelectronic Sc atom. Calculations show that the energy difference between [Ar]3d3 and [Ar]3d1 4s2 depends on Zeff. As Zeff increases, transfer of a 4s electron to a 3d orbital becomes more favourable because the electron–electron repulsions are compensated by attractive interactions between the nucleus and the electrons in the spatially compact 3d orbital. Indeed, calculations reveal that, for a sufficiently large Zeff, [Ar]3d3 is lower in energy than [Ar]3d1 4s2 . This conclusion explains why V2+ has a [Ar]3d3 configuration and also accounts for the observed [Ar]4s0 3dn configurations of the M2+ cations of Sc through Zn. The configurations of anions of the p-block elements are derived by continuing the building-up procedure and adding electrons to the neutral atom until the configuration of the next noble gas has been reached. Thus, the configuration of the O2− ion is achieved by adding two electrons to [He]2s2 2p4 , giving [He]2s2 2p6 , the same as the configuration of neon. (e) Ionization energies and electron affinities The minimum energy necessary to remove an electron from a many-electron atom in the gas phase is the first ionization energy, I1, of the element. The second ionization energy, I2, is the minimum energy needed to remove a second electron (from the Energy Fig. 10.21 Strong electron–electron repulsions in the 3d orbitals are minimized in the ground state of Sc if the atom has the configuration [Ar]3d1 4s2 (shown on the left) instead of [Ar]3d2 4s1 (shown on the right). The total energy of the atom is lower when it has the [Ar]3d1 4s2 configuration despite the cost of populating the high energy 4s orbital. Comment 10.4 The web site for this text contains links to databases of atomic properties. 10.4 THE ORBITAL APPROXIMATION 343 singly charged cation). The variation of the first ionization energy through the periodic table is shown in Fig. 10.22 and some numerical values are given in Table 10.3. In thermodynamic calculations we often need the standard enthalpy of ionization, ∆ionH7 . As shown in the Justification below, the two are related by ∆ionH7 (T) = I + 5 –2RT (10.34) At 298 K, the difference between the ionization enthalpy and the corresponding ionization energy is 6.20 kJ mol−1 . Justification 10.7 The ionization enthalpy and the ionization energy It follows from Kirchhoff’s law (Section 2.9 and eqn 2.36) that the reaction enthalpy for M(g) → M+ (g) + e− (g) at a temperature T is related to the value at T = 0 by ∆rH7 (T) = ∆rH7 (0) + Ύ Τ 0 ∆rCp 7 dT The molar constant-pressure heat capacity of each species in the reaction is 5 –2R, so ∆rC7 p = +5 –2R. The integral in this expression therefore evaluates to +5 –2RT. The reaction enthalpy at T = 0 is the same as the (molar) ionization energy, I. Equation 10.33 then follows. The same expression applies to each successive ionization step, so the overall ionization enthalpy for the formation of M2+ is ∆rH7 (T) = I1 + I2 + 5RT The electron affinity, Eea, is the energy released when an electron attaches to a gasphase atom (Table 10.4). In a common, logical, but not universal convention (which we adopt), the electron affinity is positive if energy is released when the electron attaches to the atom (that is, Eea > 0 implies that electron attachment is exothermic). It follows from a similar argument to that given in the Justification above that the standard enthalpy of electron gain, ∆egH7 , at a temperature T is related to the electron affinity by ∆egH7 (T) = −Eea − 5 –2RT (10.35) Note the change of sign. In typical thermodynamic cycles the 5 –2RT that appears in eqn 10.35 cancels that in eqn 10.34, so ionization energies and electron affinities can be used directly. A final preliminary point is that the electron-gain enthalpy of a species X is the negative of the ionization enthalpy of its negative ion: ∆egH7 (X) = −∆ionH7 (X− ) (10.36) Ionizationenergy,/eVI 0 10 20 30 1 20 40 60 80 100 Atomic number, Z He Ne Ar Kr Hg Rn Xe Li Na K Rb Cs Tl H Fig. 10.22 The first ionization energies of the elements plotted against atomic number. Synoptic table 10.3* First and second ionization energies Element I1/(kJ mol−1 ) I2/(kJ mol−1 ) H 1312 He 2372 5251 Mg 738 1451 Na 496 4562 * More values are given in the Data section. Synoptic table 10.4* Electron affinities, Ea/(kJ mol−1 ) Cl 349 F 322 H 73 O 141 O− –844 * More values are given in the Data section. 344 10 ATOMIC STRUCTURE AND ATOMIC SPECTRA As ionization energy is often easier to measure than electron affinity, this relation can be used to determine numerical values of the latter. As will be familiar from introductory chemistry, ionization energies and electron affinities show periodicities. The former is more regular and we concentrate on it. Lithium has a low first ionization energy because its outermost electron is well shielded from the nucleus by the core (Zeff = 1.3, compared with Z = 3). The ionization energy of beryllium (Z = 4) is greater but that of boron is lower because in the latter the outermost electron occupies a 2p orbital and is less strongly bound than if it had been a 2s electron. The ionization energy increases from boron to nitrogen on account of the increasing nuclear charge. However, the ionization energy of oxygen is less than would be expected by simple extrapolation. The explanation is that at oxygen a 2p orbital must become doubly occupied, and the electron–electron repulsions are increased above what would be expected by simple extrapolation along the row. In addition, the loss of a 2p electron results in a configuration with a half-filled subshell (like that of N), which is an arrangement of low energy, so the energy of O+ + e− is lower than might be expected, and the ionization energy is correspondingly low too. (The kink is less pronounced in the next row, between phosphorus and sulfur because their orbitals are more diffuse.) The values for oxygen, fluorine, and neon fall roughly on the same line, the increase of their ionization energies reflecting the increasing attraction of the more highly charged nuclei for the outermost electrons. The outermost electron in sodium is 3s. It is far from the nucleus, and the latter’s charge is shielded by the compact, complete neon-like core. As a result, the ionization energy of sodium is substantially lower than that of neon. The periodic cycle starts again along this row, and the variation of the ionization energy can be traced to similar reasons. Electron affinities are greatest close to fluorine, for the incoming electron enters a vacancy in a compact valence shell and can interact strongly with the nucleus. The attachment of an electron to an anion (as in the formation of O2− from O− ) is invariably endothermic, so Eea is negative. The incoming electron is repelled by the charge already present. Electron affinities are also small, and may be negative, when an electron enters an orbital that is far from the nucleus (as in the heavier alkali metal atoms) or is forced by the Pauli principle to occupy a new shell (as in the noble gas atoms). 10.5 Self-consistent field orbitals The central difficulty of the Schrödinger equation is the presence of the electron– electron interaction terms. The potential energy of the electrons is V = − i ∑ + 1 –2 ∑ i,j ′ (10.37) The prime on the second sum indicates that i ≠ j, and the factor of one-half prevents double-counting of electron pair repulsions (1 with 2 is the same as 2 with 1). The first term is the total attractive interaction between the electrons and the nucleus. The second term is the total repulsive interaction between the electrons; rij is the distance between electrons i and j. It is hopeless to expect to find analytical solutions of a Schrödinger equation with such a complicated potential energy term, but computational techniques are available that give very detailed and reliable numerical solutions for the wavefunctions and energies. The techniques were originally introduced by D.R. Hartree (before computers were available) and then modified by V. Fock to take into account the Pauli principle correctly. In broad outline, the Hartree–Fock selfconsistent field (HF-SCF) procedure is as follows. e2 4πε0rij Ze2 4πε0ri 10.5 SELF-CONSISTENT FIELD ORBITALS 345 Imagine that we have a rough idea of the structure of the atom. In the Ne atom, for instance, the orbital approximation suggests the configuration 1s2 2s2 2p6 with the orbitals approximated by hydrogenic atomic orbitals. Now consider one of the 2p electrons. A Schrödinger equation can be written for this electron by ascribing to it a potential energy due to the nuclear attraction and the repulsion from the other electrons. This equation has the form H(1)ψ2p(1) + V(other electrons)ψ2p(1) − V(exchange correction)ψ2p(1) = E2pψ2p(1) (10.38) A similar equation can be written for the 1s and 2s orbitals in the atom. The various terms are as follows: 1 The first term on the left is the contribution of the kinetic energy and the attraction of the electron to the nucleus, just as in a hydrogenic atom. 2 The second takes into account the potential energy of the electron of interest due to the electrons in the other occupied orbitals. 3 The third term takes into account the spin correlation effects discussed earlier. Although the equation is for the 2p orbital in neon, it depends on the wavefunctions of all the other occupied orbitals in the atom. There is no hope of solving eqn 10.38 analytically. However, it can be solved numerically if we guess an approximate form of the wavefunctions of all the orbitals except 2p. The procedure is then repeated for the other orbitals in the atom, the 1s and 2s orbitals. This sequence of calculations gives the form of the 2p, 2s, and 1s orbitals, and in general they will differ from the set used initially to start the calculation. These improved orbitals can be used in another cycle of calculation, and a second improved set of orbitals is obtained. The recycling continues until the orbitals and energies obtained are insignificantly different from those used at the start of the current cycle. The solutions are then self-consistent and accepted as solutions of the problem. Figure 10.23 shows plots of some of the HF-SCF radial distribution functions for sodium. They show the grouping of electron density into shells, as was anticipated by the early chemists, and the differences of penetration as discussed above. These SCF calculations therefore support the qualitative discussions that are used to explain chemical periodicity. They also considerably extend that discussion by providing detailed wavefunctions and precise energies. The spectra of complex atoms The spectra of atoms rapidly become very complicated as the number of electrons increases, but there are some important and moderately simple features that make atomic spectroscopy useful in the study of the composition of samples as large and as complex as stars (Impact I10.1). The general idea is straightforward: lines in the spectrum (in either emission or absorption) occur when the atom undergoes a transition with a change of energy |∆E|, and emits or absorbs a photon of frequency ν = |∆E|/h and # = |∆E|/hc. Hence, we can expect the spectrum to give information about the energies of electrons in atoms. However, the actual energy levels are not given solely by the energies of the orbitals, because the electrons interact with one another in various ways, and there are contributions to the energy in addition to those we have already considered. 0 1 2 Radialdistributionfunction,P 2p 2s 3s 1s r/a0 K L M Fig. 10.23 The radial distribution functions for the orbitals of Na based on SCF calculations. Note the shell-like structure, with the 3s orbital outside the inner K and L shells. Comment 10.5 The web site for this text contains links to databases of atomic spectra. 346 10 ATOMIC STRUCTURE AND ATOMIC SPECTRA IMPACT ON ASTROPHYSICS I10.1 Spectroscopy of stars The bulk of stellar material consists of neutral and ionized forms of hydrogen and helium atoms, with helium being the product of ‘hydrogen burning’ by nuclear fusion. However, nuclear fusion also makes heavier elements. It is generally accepted that the outer layers of stars are composed of lighter elements, such as H, He, C, N, O, and Ne in both neutral and ionized forms. Heavier elements, including neutral and ionized forms of Si, Mg, Ca, S, and Ar, are found closer to the stellar core. The core itself contains the heaviest elements and 56 Fe is particularly abundant because it is a very stable nuclide. All these elements are in the gas phase on account of the very high temperatures in stellar interiors. For example, the temperature is estimated to be 3.6 MK half way to the centre of the Sun. Astronomers use spectroscopic techniques to determine the chemical composition of stars because each element, and indeed each isotope of an element, has a characteristic spectral signature that is transmitted through space by the star’s light. To understand the spectra of stars, we must first know why they shine. Nuclear reactions in the dense stellar interior generate radiation that travels to less dense outer layers. Absorption and re-emission of photons by the atoms and ions in the interior give rise to a quasi-continuum of radiation energy that is emitted into space by a thin layer of gas called the photosphere. To a good approximation, the distribution of energy emitted from a star’s photosphere resembles the Planck distribution for a very hot black body (Section 8.1). For example, the energy distribution of our Sun’s photosphere may be modelled by a Planck distribution with an effective temperature of 5.8 kK. Superimposed on the black-body radiation continuum are sharp absorption and emission lines from neutral atoms and ions present in the photosphere. Analysis of stellar radiation with a spectrometer mounted on to a telescope yields the chemical composition of the star’s photosphere by comparison with known spectra of the elements. The data can also reveal the presence of small molecules, such as CN, C2, TiO, and ZrO, in certain ‘cold’ stars, which are stars with relatively low effective temperatures. The two outermost layers of a star are the chromosphere, a region just above the photosphere, and the corona, a region above the chromosphere that can be seen (with proper care) during eclipses. The photosphere, chromosphere, and corona comprise a star’s ‘atmosphere’. Our Sun’s chromosphere is much less dense than its photosphere and its temperature is much higher, rising to about 10 kK. The reasons for this increase in temperature are not fully understood. The temperature of our Sun’s corona is very high, rising up to 1.5 MK, so black-body emission is strong from the X-ray to the radiofrequency region of the spectrum. The spectrum of the Sun’s corona is dominated by emission lines from electronically excited species, such as neutral atoms and a number of highly ionized species . The most intense emission lines in the visible range are from the Fe13+ ion at 530.3 nm, the Fe9+ ion at 637.4 nm, and the Ca4+ ion at 569.4 nm. Because only light from the photosphere reaches our telescopes, the overall chemical composition of a star must be inferred from theoretical work on its interior and from spectral analysis of its atmosphere. Data on the Sun indicate that it is 92 per cent hydrogen and 7.8 per cent helium. The remaining 0.2 per cent is due to heavier elements, among which C, N, O, Ne, and Fe are the most abundant. More advanced analysis of spectra also permit the determination of other properties of stars, such as their relative speeds (Problem 10.27) and their effective temperatures (Problem 13.29). 10.6 Quantum defects and ionization limits One application of atomic spectroscopy is to the determination of ionization energies. However, we cannot use the procedure illustrated in Example 10.1 indiscriminately 10.7 SINGLET AND TRIPLET STATES 347 because the energy levels of a many-electron atom do not in general vary as 1/n2 . If we confine attention to the outermost electrons, then we know that, as a result of penetration and shielding, they experience a nuclear charge of slightly more than 1e because in a neutral atom the other Z − 1 electrons cancel all but about one unit of nuclear charge. Typical values of Zeff are a little more than 1, so we expect binding energies to be given by a term of the form −hcR/n2 , but lying slightly lower in energy than this formula predicts. We therefore introduce a quantumdefect, δ, and write the energy as −hcR/(n − δ)2 . The quantum defect is best regarded as a purely empirical quantity. There are some excited states that are so diffuse that the 1/n2 variation is valid: these states are called Rydberg states. In such cases we can write # = − (10.39) and a plot of wavenumber against 1/n2 can be used to obtain I by extrapolation; in practice, one would use a linear regression fit using a computer. If the lower state is not the ground state (a possibility if we wish to generalize the concept of ionization energy), the ionization energy of the ground state can be determined by adding the appropriate energy difference to the ionization energy obtained as described here. 10.7 Singlet and triplet states Suppose we were interested in the energy levels of a He atom, with its two electrons. We know that the ground-state configuration is 1s2 , and can anticipate that an excited configuration will be one in which one of the electrons has been promoted into a 2s orbital, giving the configuration 1s1 2s1 . The two electrons need not be paired because they occupy different orbitals. According to Hund’s maximum multiplicity rule, the state of the atom with the spins parallel lies lower in energy than the state in which they are paired. Both states are permissible, and can contribute to the spectrum of the atom. Parallel and antiparallel (paired) spins differ in their overall spin angular momentum. In the paired case, the two spin momenta cancel each other, and there is zero net spin (as was depicted in Fig. 10.18). The paired-spin arrangement is called a singlet. Its spin state is the one we denoted σ− in the discussion of the Pauli principle: σ−(1,2) = (1/21/2 ){α(1)β(2) − β(1)α(2)} (10.40a) The angular momenta of two parallel spins add together to give a nonzero total spin, and the resulting state is called a triplet. As illustrated in Fig. 10.24, there are three ways of achieving a nonzero total spin, but only one way to achieve zero spin. The three spin states are the symmetric combinations introduced earlier: α(1)α(2) σ+(1,2) = (1/21/2 ){α(1)β(2) + β(1)α(2)} β(1)β(2) (10.40b) The fact that the parallel arrangement of spins in the 1s1 2s1 configuration of the He atom lies lower in energy than the antiparallel arrangement can now be expressed by saying that the triplet state of the 1s1 2s1 configuration of He lies lower in energy than the singlet state. This is a general conclusion that applies to other atoms (and molecules) and, for states arising from the same configuration, the triplet state generally lies lower than the singlet state. The origin of the energy difference lies in the effect of spin correlation on the Coulombic interactions between electrons, as we saw in the case of Hund’s rule for ground-state configurations. Because the Coulombic interaction between electrons in an atom is strong, the difference in energies between singlet and triplet states of the same configuration can be large. The two states of 1s1 2s1 He, for instance, differ by 6421 cm−1 (corresponding to 0.80 eV). R n2 I hc MS 0= ms = + ms = MS 1= +ms = + ms = + MS 1= ms = -ms = - 2 1 - 2 1 - 2 1 - 2 1 - 2 1 -2 1 Fig. 10.24 When two electrons have parallel spins, they have a nonzero total spin angular momentum. There are three ways of achieving this resultant, which are shown by these vector representations. Note that, although we cannot know the orientation of the spin vectors on the cones, the angle between the vectors is the same in all three cases, for all three arrangements have the same total spin angular momentum (that is, the resultant of the two vectors has the same length in each case, but points in different directions). Compare this diagram with Fig. 10.18, which shows the antiparallel case. Note that, whereas two paired spins are precisely antiparallel, two ‘parallel’ spins are not strictly parallel. 348 10 ATOMIC STRUCTURE AND ATOMIC SPECTRA The spectrum of atomic helium is more complicated than that of atomic hydrogen, but there are two simplifying features. One is that the only excited configurations it is necessary to consider are of the form 1s1 nl1 : that is, only one electron is excited. Excitation of two electrons requires an energy greater than the ionization energy of the atom, so the He+ ion is formed instead of the doubly excited atom. Second, no radiative transitions take place between singlet and triplet states because the relative orientation of the two electron spins cannot change during a transition. Thus, there is a spectrum arising from transitions between singlet states (including the ground state) and between triplet states, but not between the two. Spectroscopically, helium behaves like two distinct species, and the early spectroscopists actually thought of helium as consisting of ‘parahelium’ and ‘orthohelium’. The Grotrian diagram for helium in Fig. 10.25 shows the two sets of transitions. 10.8 Spin–orbit coupling An electron has a magnetic moment that arises from its spin (Fig. 10.26). Similarly, an electron with orbital angular momentum (that is, an electron in an orbital with l > 0) is in effect a circulating current, and possesses a magnetic moment that arises from its orbital momentum. The interaction of the spin magnetic moment with the magnetic field arising from the orbital angular momentum is called spin–orbit coupling. The strength of the coupling, and its effect on the energy levels of the atom, depend on the relative orientations of the spin and orbital magnetic moments, and therefore on the relative orientations of the two angular momenta (Fig. 10.27). (a) The total angular momentum One way of expressing the dependence of the spin–orbit interaction on the relative orientation of the spin and orbital momenta is to say that it depends on the total angular momentum of the electron, the vector sum of its spin and orbital momenta. Thus, when the spin and orbital angular momenta are nearly parallel, the total angular 1 S 1 P 1 D 1 F 3 S 3 P 3 D 3 F -24.5 0 -10 -20 Energy/eV 1083 587.6667.8 58.44 53.71 52.22 51.56 Fig. 10.25 Part of the Grotrian diagram for a helium atom. Note that there are no transitions between the singlet and triplet levels. Comment 10.6 We have already remarked that the electron’s spin is a purely quantum mechanical phenomenon that has no classical counterpart. However a classical model can give us partial insight into the origin of an electron’s magnetic moment. Namely, the magnetic field generated by a spinning electron, regarded classically as a moving charge, induces a magnetic moment. This model is merely a visualization aid and cannot be used to explain the magnitude of the magnetic moment of the electron or the origin of spin magnetic moments in electrically neutral particles, such as the neutron. 10.8 SPIN–ORBIT COUPLING 349 l = el = 2 es s m m g g Fig. 10.26 Angular momentum gives rise to a magnetic moment (µ). For an electron, the magnetic moment is antiparallel to the orbital angular momentum, but proportional to it. For spin angular momentum, there is a factor 2, which increases the magnetic moment to twice its expected value (see Section 10.10). l l s s High energy High j Low j Low energy (a) (b) Fig. 10.27 Spin–orbit coupling is a magnetic interaction between spin and orbital magnetic moments. When the angular momenta are parallel, as in (a), the magnetic moments are aligned unfavourably; when they are opposed, as in (b), the interaction is favourable. This magnetic coupling is the cause of the splitting of a configuration into levels. s = 1 s = 1 l2= l2= j=5 j=3 –2 2– 2 – –2 Fig. 10.28 The coupling of the spin and orbital angular momenta of a d electron (l = 2) gives two possible values of j depending on the relative orientations of the spin and orbital angular momenta of the electron. momentum is high; when the two angular momenta are opposed, the total angular momentum is low. The total angular momentum of an electron is described by the quantum numbers j and mj, with j = l + 1 –2 (when the two angular momenta are in the same direction) or j = l − 1 –2 (when they are opposed, Fig. 10.28). The different values of j that can arise for a given value of l label levels of a term. For l = 0, the only permitted value is j = 1 –2 (the total angular momentum is the same as the spin angular momentum because there is no other source of angular momentum in the atom). When l = 1, j may be either 3 –2 (the spin and orbital angular momenta are in the same sense) or 1 –2 (the spin and angular momenta are in opposite senses). Example 10.4 Identifying the levels of a configuration Identify the levels that may arise from the configurations (a) d1 , (b) s1 . Method In each case, identify the value of l and then the possible values of j. For these one-electron systems, the total angular momentum is the sum and difference of the orbital and spin momenta. Answer (a) For a d electron, l = 2 and there are two levels in the configuration, one with j = 2 + 1 –2 = 5 –2 and the other with j = 2 − 1 –2 = 3 –2. (b) For an s electron l = 0, so only one level is possible, and j = 1 –2. Self-test 10.8 Identify the levels of the configurations (a) p1 and (b) f1 . [(a) 3 –2, 1 –2; (b) 7 –2, 5 –2] 350 10 ATOMIC STRUCTURE AND ATOMIC SPECTRA Comment 10.7 The scalar product (or dot product) u·1 of two vectors u and 1 with magnitudes u and 1 is u·1 = u1 cos θ, where θ is the angle between the two vectors. 2p1 j = j = + hcA –hcA Energy 2 3 - 2 1 - 2 1 Fig. 10.29 The levels of a 2 P term arising from spin–orbit coupling. Note that the low-j level lies below the high-j level in energy. The dependence of the spin–orbit interaction on the value of j is expressed in terms of the spin–orbit coupling constant, A (which is typically expressed as a wavenumber). A quantum mechanical calculation leads to the result that the energies of the levels with quantum numbers s, l, and j are given by El,s,j = 1 –2hcA{j(j + 1) − l(l + 1) − s(s + 1)} (10.41) Justification 10.8 The energy of spin–orbit interaction The energy of a magnetic moment µ in a magnetic field B is equal to their scalar product −µ ·B. If the magnetic field arises from the orbital angular momentum of the electron, it is proportional to l; if the magnetic moment µ is that of the electron spin, then it is proportional to s. It then follows that the energy of interaction is proportional to the scalar product s·l: Energy of interaction = −µ ·B ∝ s·l Wetakethisexpressiontobethefirst-orderperturbationcontributiontothehamiltonian. Next, we note that the total angular momentum is the vector sum of the spin and orbital momenta: j = l + s. The magnitude of the vector j is calculated by evaluating j·j = (l + s)·(l + s) = l·l + s·s + 2s·l That is, s·l = 1–2{j2 − l2 − s2 } where we have used the fact that the scalar product of two vectors u and v is u·v = uv cos θ, from which it follows that u·u = u2 . The preceding equation is a classical result. To make the transition to quantum mechanics, we treat all the quantities as operators, and write £·™ = 1–2{¡2 − ™2 − £2 } (10.42) At this point, we calculate the first-order correction to the energy by evaluating the expectation value: ͗j,l,s|£·™|j,l,s͘ = 1–2 ͗j,l,s|¡2 − ™2 − s2 |j,l,s͘ = 1–2 {j(j + 1) − l(l + 1) − s(s + 1)}$2 (10.43) Then, by inserting this expression into the formula for the energy of interaction (E ∝ s·l), and writing the constant of proportionality as hcA/$2 , we obtain eqn 10.42. The calculation of A is much more complicated: see Further reading. Illustration 10.3 Calculating the energies of levels The unpaired electron in the ground state of an alkali metal atom has l = 0, so j = 1 –2. Because the orbital angular momentum is zero in this state, the spin–orbit coupling energy is zero (as is confirmed by setting j = s and l = 0 in eqn 10.41). When the electron is excited to an orbital with l = 1, it has orbital angular momentum and can give rise to a magnetic field that interacts with its spin. In this configuration the electron can have j = 3 –2 or j = 1 –2, and the energies of these levels are E3/2 = 1 –2hcA{3 –2 × 5 –2 − 1 × 2 − 1 –2 × 3 –2} = 1 –2hcA E1/2 = 1 –2hcA{1 –2 × 3 –2 − 1 × 2 − 1 –2 × 3 –2} = −hcA The corresponding energies are shown in Fig. 10.29. Note that the baricentre (the ‘centre of gravity’) of the levels is unchanged, because there are four states of energy 1 –2hcA and two of energy −hcA. 10.8 SPIN–ORBIT COUPLING 351 D1 D2 2 P1/2 2 P3/2 17 cm 1 2 S1/2 16 973 16 956 0 589.76nm 589.16nm n~ /cm 1~n - Fig. 10.30 The energy-level diagram for the formation of the sodium D lines. The splitting of the spectral lines (by 17 cm−1 ) reflects the splitting of the levels of the 2 P term. The strength of the spin–orbit coupling depends on the nuclear charge. To understand why this is so, imagine riding on the orbiting electron and seeing a charged nucleus apparently orbiting around us (like the Sun rising and setting). As a result, we find ourselves at the centre of a ring of current. The greater the nuclear charge, the greater this current, and therefore the stronger the magnetic field we detect. Because the spin magnetic moment of the electron interacts with this orbital magnetic field, it follows that the greater the nuclear charge, the stronger the spin–orbit interaction. The coupling increases sharply with atomic number (as Z4 ). Whereas it is only small in H (giving rise to shifts of energy levels of no more than about 0.4 cm−1 ), in heavy atoms like Pb it is very large (giving shifts of the order of thousands of reciprocal centimetres). (b) Fine structure Two spectral lines are observed when the p electron of an electronically excited alkali metal atom undergoes a transition and falls into a lower s orbital. One line is due to a transition starting in a j = 3 –2 level and the other line is due to a transition starting in the j = 1 –2 level of the same configuration. The two lines are an example of the fine structure of a spectrum, the structure in a spectrum due to spin–orbit coupling. Fine structure can be clearly seen in the emission spectrum from sodium vapour excited by an electric discharge (for example, in one kind of street lighting). The yellow line at 589 nm (close to 17 000 cm−1 ) is actually a doublet composed of one line at 589.76 nm (16 956.2 cm−1 ) and another at 589.16 nm (16 973.4 cm−1 ); the components of this doublet are the ‘D lines’ of the spectrum (Fig. 10.30). Therefore, in Na, the spin–orbit coupling affects the energies by about 17 cm−1 . Example 10.5 Analysing a spectrum for the spin–orbit coupling constant The origin of the D lines in the spectrum of atomic sodium is shown in Fig. 10.30. Calculate the spin–orbit coupling constant for the upper configuration of the Na atom. Method We see from Fig. 10.30 that the splitting of the lines is equal to the energy separation of the j = 3 –2 and 1 –2 levels of the excited configuration. This separation can be expressed in terms of A by using eqn 10.40. Therefore, set the observed splitting equal to the energy separation calculated from eqn 10.40 and solve the equation for A. Answer The two levels are split by ∆# = A 1 –2{3 –2(3 –2 + 1) − 1 –2(1 –2 + 1)} = 3 –2A The experimental value is 17.2 cm−1 ; therefore A = 2 –3 × (17.2 cm−1 ) = 11.5 cm−1 The same calculation repeated for the other alkali metal atoms gives Li: 0.23 cm−1 , K: 38.5 cm−1 , Rb: 158 cm−1 , Cs: 370 cm−1 . Note the increase of A with atomic number (but more slowly than Z4 for these many-electron atoms). Self-test 10.9 The configuration . . . 4p6 5d1 of rubidium has two levels at 25 700.56 cm−1 and 25 703.52 cm−1 above the ground state. What is the spin–orbit coupling constant in this excited state? [1.18 cm−1 ] 352 10 ATOMIC STRUCTURE AND ATOMIC SPECTRA 10.9 Term symbols and selection rules We have used expressions such as ‘the j = 3 –2 level of a configuration’. A term symbol, which is a symbol looking like 2 P3/2 or 3 D2, conveys this information much more succinctly. The convention of using lowercase letters to label orbitals and uppercase letters to label overall states applies throughout spectroscopy, not just to atoms. A term symbol gives three pieces of information: 1 The letter (P or D in the examples) indicates the total orbital angular momentum quantum number, L. 2 The left superscript in the term symbol (the 2 in 2 P3/2) gives the multiplicity of the term. 3 The right subscript on the term symbol (the 3 –2 in 2 P3/2) is the value of the total angular momentum quantum number, J. We shall now say what each of these statements means; the contributions to the energies which we are about to discuss are summarized in Fig. 10.31. (a) The total orbital angular momentum When several electrons are present, it is necessary to judge how their individual orbital angular momenta add together or oppose each other. The total orbital angular momentum quantum number, L, tells us the magnitude of the angular momentum through {L(L + 1)}1/2 $. It has 2L + 1 orientations distinguished by the quantum number ML, which can take the values L, L − 1, . . . , −L. Similar remarks apply to the total spin quantum number, S, and the quantum number MS, and the total angular momentum quantum number, J, and the quantum number MJ. The value of L (a non-negative integer) is obtained by coupling the individual orbital angular momenta by using the Clebsch–Gordan series: L = l1 + l2, l1 + l2 − 1, . . . , |l1 − l2| (10.44) The modulus signs are attached to l1 − l2 because L is non-negative. The maximum value, L = l1 + l2, is obtained when the two orbital angular momenta are in the same direction; the lowest value, |l1 − l2|, is obtained when they are in opposite directions. The intermediate values represent possible intermediate relative orientations of the two momenta (Fig. 10.32). For two p electrons (for which l1 = l2 = 1), L = 2, 1, 0. The code for converting the value of L into a letter is the same as for the s, p, d, f, . . . designation of orbitals, but uses uppercase Roman letters: L: 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 . . . S P D F G H I . . . Thus, a p2 configuration can give rise to D, P, and S terms. The terms differ in energy on account of the different spatial distribution of the electrons and the consequent differences in repulsion between them. A closed shell has zero orbital angular momentum because all the individual orbital angular momenta sum to zero. Therefore, when working out term symbols, we need consider only the electrons of the unfilled shell. In the case of a single electron outside a closed shell, the value of L is the same as the value of l; so the configuration [Ne]3s1 has only an S term. D P S 5 P 3 P 1 P 3 P2 3 P1 3 P0 Configuration Electrostatic Spin correlation + electrostatic Magnetic (spin orbit)Fig. 10.31 A summary of the types of interaction that are responsible for the various kinds of splitting of energy levels in atoms. For light atoms, magnetic interactions are small, but in heavy atoms they may dominate the electrostatic (charge–charge) interactions. l = 1 l = 1 l= 1 l=2 l=2 l=2 L=3 L = 2 L = 1 Fig. 10.32 The total angular orbital momenta of a p electron and a d electron correspond to L = 3, 2, and 1 and reflect the different relative orientations of the two momenta. 10.9 TERM SYMBOLS AND SELECTION RULES 353 Comment 10.8 Throughout our discussion of atomic spectroscopy, distinguish italic S, the total spin quantum number, from Roman S, the term label. s= s= s= s = S 1 =S 0= (a) (b) 2 1 –2 1 - 2 1 - 2 1 Fig. 10.33 For two electrons (each of which has s = 1–2), only two total spin states are permitted (S = 0, 1). The state with S = 0 can have only one value of MS (MS = 0) and is a singlet; the state with S = 1 can have any of three values of MS (+1, 0, −1) and is a triplet. The vector representation of the singlet and triplet states are shown in Figs. 10.18 and 10.24, respectively. Example 10.6 Deriving the total orbital angular momentum of a configuration Find the terms that can arise from the configurations (a) d2 , (b) p3 . Method Use the Clebsch–Gordan series and begin by finding the minimum value of L (so that we know where the series terminates). When there are more than two electrons to couple together, use two series in succession: first couple two electrons, and then couple the third to each combined state, and so on. Answer (a) The minimum value is |l1 − l2| = |2 − 2| = 0. Therefore, L = 2 + 2, 2 + 2 − 1, . . . , 0 = 4, 3, 2, 1, 0 corresponding to G, F, D, P, S terms, respectively. (b) Coupling two electrons gives a minimum value of |1 − 1| = 0. Therefore, L′ = 1 + 1, 1 + 1 − 1, . . . , 0 = 2, 1, 0 Now couple l3 with L′ = 2, to give L = 3, 2, 1; with L′ = 1, to give L = 2, 1, 0; and with L′ = 0, to give L = 1. The overall result is L = 3, 2, 2, 1, 1, 1, 0 giving one F, two D, three P, and one S term. Self-test 10.10 Repeat the question for the configurations (a) f1 d1 and (b) d3 . [(a) H, G, F, D, P; (b) I, 2H, 3G, 4F, 5D, 3P, S] (b) The multiplicity When there are several electrons to be taken into account, we must assess their total spin angular momentum quantum number, S (a non-negative integer or half integer). Once again, we use the Clebsch–Gordan series in the form S = s1 + s2, s1 + s2 − 1, . . . , |s1 − s2| (10.45) to decide on the value of S, noting that each electron has s = 1 –2, which gives S = 1, 0 for two electrons (Fig. 10.33). If there are three electrons, the total spin angular momentum is obtained by coupling the third spin to each of the values of S for the first two spins, which results in S = 3 –2, and S = 1 –2. The multiplicity of a term is the value of 2S + 1. When S = 0 (as for a closed shell, like 1s2 ) the electrons are all paired and there is no net spin: this arrangement gives a singlet term, 1 S. A single electron has S = s = 1 –2, so a configuration such as [Ne]3s1 can give rise to a doublet term, 2 S. Likewise, the configuration [Ne]3p1 is a doublet, 2 P. When there are two unpaired electrons S = 1, so 2S + 1 = 3, giving a triplet term, such as 3 D. We discussed the relative energies of singlets and triplets in Section 10.7 and saw that their energies differ on account of the different effects of spin correlation. (c) The total angular momentum As we have seen, the quantum number j tells us the relative orientation of the spin and orbital angular momenta of a single electron. The total angular momentum quantumnumber, J (a non-negative integer or half integer), does the same for several electrons. If there is a single electron outside a closed shell, J = j, with j either l + 1 –2 or |l − 1 –2 |. The [Ne]3s1 configuration has j = 1 –2 (because l = 0 and s = 1 –2), so the 2s term has a single level, which we denote 2 S1/2. The [Ne]3p1 configuration has l = 1; therefore 354 10 ATOMIC STRUCTURE AND ATOMIC SPECTRA j = 3 –2 and 1 –2; the 2 P term therefore has two levels, 2 P3/2 and 2 P1/2. These levels lie at different energies on account of the magnetic spin–orbit interaction. If there are several electrons outside a closed shell we have to consider the coupling of all the spins and all the orbital angular momenta. This complicated problem can be simplified when the spin–orbit coupling is weak (for atoms of low atomic number), for then we can use the Russell–Saunders coupling scheme. This scheme is based on the view that, if spin–orbit coupling is weak, then it is effective only when all the orbital momenta are operating cooperatively. We therefore imagine that all the orbital angular momenta of the electrons couple to give a total L, and that all the spins are similarly coupled to give a total S. Only at this stage do we imagine the two kinds of momenta coupling through the spin–orbit interaction to give a total J. The permitted values of J are given by the Clebsch–Gordan series J = L + S, L + S − 1, . . . , |L − S| (10.46) For example, in the case of the 3 D term of the configuration [Ne]2p1 3p1 , the permitted values of J are 3, 2, 1 (because 3 D has L = 2 and S = 1), so the term has three levels, 3 D3, 3 D2, and 3 D1. When L ≥ S, the multiplicity is equal to the number of levels. For example, a 2 P term has the two levels 2 P3/2 and 2 P1/2, and 3 D has the three levels 3 D3, 3 D2, and 3 D1. However, this is not the case when L < S: the term 2 S, for example, has only the one level 2 S1/2. Example 10.7 Deriving term symbols Write the term symbols arising from the ground-state configurations of (a) Na and (b) F, and (c) the excited configuration 1s2 2s2 2p1 3p1 of C. Method Begin by writing the configurations, but ignore inner closed shells. Then couple the orbital momenta to find L and the spins to find S. Next, couple L and S to find J. Finally, express the term as 2S+1 {L}J, where {L} is the appropriate letter. For F, for which the valence configuration is 2p5 , treat the single gap in the closed-shell 2p6 configuration as a single particle. Answer (a) For Na, the configuration is [Ne]3s1 , and we consider the single 3s electron. Because L = l = 0 and S = s = 1 –2, it is possible for J = j = s = 1 –2 only. Hence the term symbol is 2 S1/2. (b) For F, the configuration is [He]2s2 2p5 , which we can treat as [Ne]2p−1 (where the notation 2p−1 signifies the absence of a 2p electron). Hence L = 1, and S = s = 1 –2. Two values of J = j are allowed: J = 3 –2, 1 –2. Hence, the term symbols for the two levels are 2 P3/2, 2 P1/2. (c) We are treating an excited configuration of carbon because, in the ground configuration, 2p2 , the Pauli principle forbids some terms, and deciding which survive (1 D, 3 P, 1 S, in fact) is quite complicated. That is, there is a distinction between ‘equivalent electrons’, which are electrons that occupy the same orbitals, and ‘inequivalent electrons’, which are electrons that occupy different orbitals. For information about how to deal with equivalent electrons, see Further reading. The excited configuration of C under consideration is effectively 2p1 3p1 . This is a two-electron problem, and l1 = l2 = 1, s1 = s2 = 1 –2. It follows that L = 2, 1, 0 and S = 1, 0. The terms are therefore 3 D and 1 D, 3 P and 1 P, and 3 S and 1 S. For 3 D, L = 2 and S = 1; hence J = 3, 2, 1 and the levels are 3 D3, 3 D2, and 3 D1. For 1 D, L = 2 and S = 0, so the single level is 1 D2. The triplet of levels of 3 P is 3 P2, 3 P1, and 3 P0, and the singlet is 1 P1. For the 3 S term there is only one level, 3 S1 (because J = 1 only), and the singlet term is 1 S0. 10.9 TERM SYMBOLS AND SELECTION RULES 355 Si Ge Sn Pb 1 S0 1 D2 3 P23 P13 P0 Pure Russell–Saunders coupling Pure -couplingjj C Fig. 10.34 The correlation diagram for some of the states of a two-electron system. All atoms lie between the two extremes, but the heavier the atom, the closer it lies to the pure jj-coupling case. Self-test 10.11 Write down the terms arising from the configurations (a) 2s1 2p1 , (b) 2p1 3d1 . [(a) 3 P2, 3 P1, 3 P0, 1 P1; (b) 3 F4, 3 F3, 3 F2, 1 F3, 3 D3, 3 D2, 3 D1, 1 D2, 3 P1, 3 P0, 1 P1] Russell–Saunders coupling fails when the spin–orbit coupling is large (in heavy atoms). In that case, the individual spin and orbital momenta of the electrons are coupled into individual j values; then these momenta are combined into a grand total, J. This scheme is called jj-coupling. For example, in a p2 configuration, the individual values of j are 3 –2 and 1 –2 for each electron. If the spin and the orbital angular momentum of each electron are coupled together strongly, it is best to consider each electron as a particle with angular momentum j = 3 –2 or 1 –2. These individual total momenta then couple as follows: j1 = 3 –2 and j2 = 3 –2 J = 3, 2, 1, 0 j1 = 3 –2 and j2 = 1 –2 J = 2, 1 j1 = 1 –2 and j2 = 3 –2 J = 2, 1 j1 = 1 –2 and j2 = 1 –2 J = 1, 0 For heavy atoms, in which jj-coupling is appropriate, it is best to discuss their energies using these quantum numbers. Although jj-coupling should be used for assessing the energies of heavy atoms, the term symbols derived from Russell–Saunders coupling can still be used as labels. To see why this procedure is valid, we need to examine how the energies of the atomic states change as the spin–orbit coupling increases in strength. Such a correlation diagram is shown in Fig. 10.34. It shows that there is a correspondence between the low spin–orbit coupling (Russell–Saunders coupling) and high spin–orbit coupling (jj-coupling) schemes, so the labels derived by using the Russell–Saunders scheme can be used to label the states of the jj-coupling scheme. (d) Selection rules Any state of the atom, and any spectral transition, can be specified by using term symbols. For example, the transitions giving rise to the yellow sodium doublet (which were shown in Fig. 10.30) are 3p1 2 P3/2 → 3s1 2 S1/2 3p1 2 P1/2 → 3s1 2 S1/2 By convention, the upper term precedes the lower. The corresponding absorptions are therefore denoted 2 P3/2 ← 2 S1/2 2 P1/2 ← 2 S1/2 (The configurations have been omitted.) We have seen that selection rules arise from the conservation of angular momentum during a transition and from the fact that a photon has a spin of 1. They can therefore be expressed in terms of the term symbols, because the latter carry information about angular momentum. A detailed analysis leads to the following rules: ∆S = 0 ∆L = 0, ±1 ∆l = ±1 ∆J = 0, ±1, but J = 0 ←|→J = 0 (10.47) where the symbol ←|→ denotes a forbidden transition. The rule about ∆S (no change of overall spin) stems from the fact that the light does not affect the spin directly. The rules about ∆L and ∆l express the fact that the orbital angular momentum of an 356 10 ATOMIC STRUCTURE AND ATOMIC SPECTRA individual electron must change (so ∆l = ±1), but whether or not this results in an overall change of orbital momentum depends on the coupling. The selection rules given above apply when Russell–Saunders coupling is valid (in light atoms). If we insist on labelling the terms of heavy atoms with symbols like 3 D, then we shall find that the selection rules progressively fail as the atomic number increases because the quantum numbers S and L become ill defined as jj-coupling becomes more appropriate. As explained above, Russell–Saunders term symbols are only a convenient way of labelling the terms of heavy atoms: they do not bear any direct relation to the actual angular momenta of the electrons in a heavy atom. For this reason, transitions between singlet and triplet states (for which ∆S = ±1), while forbidden in light atoms, are allowed in heavy atoms. Checklist of key ideas 1. A hydrogenic atom is a one-electron atom or ion of general atomic number Z. A many-electron (polyelectronic) atom is an atom or ion with more than one electron. 2. The Lyman, Balmer, and Paschen series in the spectrum of atomic hydrogen arise, respectively, from the transitions n → 1, n → 2, and n → 3. 3. The wavenumbers of all the spectral lines of a hydrogen atom can be expressed as # = RH(1/n1 2 − 1/n2 2 ), where RH is the Rydberg constant for hydrogen. 4. The Ritz combination principle states that the wavenumber of any spectral line is the difference between two spectroscopic energy levels, or terms: # = T1 − T2. 5. The wavefunction of the hydrogen atom is the product of a radial wavefunction and a radial wavefunction: ψ(r,θ,φ) = R(r)Y(θ,φ). 6. An atomic orbital is a one-electron wavefunction for an electron in an atom. 7. The energies of an electron in a hydrogen atom are given by En = −Z2 µe4 /32π2 ε2 0$2 n2 , where n is the principal quantum number, n = 1, 2, . . . . 8. All the orbitals of a given value of n belong to a given shell; orbitals with the same value of n but different values of l belong to different subshells. 9. The radial distribution function is a probability density that, when it is multiplied by dr, gives the probability of finding the electron anywhere in a shell of thickness dr at the radius r; P(r) = r2 R(r)2 . 10. A selection rule is a statement about which spectroscopic transitions are allowed; a Grotrian diagram is a diagram summarizing the energies of the states and atom and the transitions between them. 11. In the orbital approximation it is supposed that each electron occupies its ‘own’ orbital, ψ(r1,r2, . . . ) = ψ(r1)ψ(r2) . . . . 12. The Pauli exclusion principle states that no more than two electrons may occupy any given orbital and, if two do occupy one orbital, then their spins must be paired. 13. The Pauli principle states that, when the labels of any two identical fermions are exchanged, the total wavefunction changes sign; when the labels of any two identical bosons are exchanged, the total wavefunction retains the same sign. 14. The effective nuclear charge Zeff is the net charge experienced by an electron allowing for electron–electron repulsions. 15. Shielding is the effective reduction in charge of a nucleus by surrounding electrons; the shielding constant σ is given by Zeff = Z − σ. 16. Penetration is the ability of an electron to be found inside inner shells and close to the nucleus. 17. The building-up (Aufbau) principle is the procedure for filling atomic orbitals that leads to the ground-state configuration of an atom. 18. Hund’s maximum multiplicity rule states that an atom in its ground state adopts a configuration with the greatest number of unpaired electrons. 19. The first ionization energy I1 is the minimum energy necessary to remove an electron from a many-electron atom in the gas phase; the second ionization energy I2 is the minimum energy necessary to remove an electron from an ionized many-electron atom in the gas phase. 20. The electron affinity Eea is the energy released when an electron attaches to a gas-phase atom. 21. A singlet term has S = 0; a triplet term has S = 1. 22. Spin–orbit coupling is the interaction of the spin magnetic moment with the magnetic field arising from the orbital angular momentum. 23. Fine structure is the structure in a spectrum due to spin–orbit coupling. 24. A term symbol is a symbolic specification of the state of an atom, 2S+1 {L}J. 25. The allowed values of a combined angular momenta are obtained by using the Clebsch–Gordan series: J = j1 + j2, j1 + j2 − 1, . . . |j1 − j2|. FURTHER INFORMATION 357 26. The multiplicity of a term is the value of 2S + 1; provided L ≥ S, the multiplicity is the number of levels of the term. 28. A level is a group of states with a common value of J. 29. Russell–Saunders coupling is a coupling scheme based on the view that, if spin–orbit coupling is weak, then it is effective only when all the orbital momenta are operating cooperatively. 30. jj-Coupling is a coupling scheme based on the view that the individual spin and orbital momenta of the electrons are coupled into individual j values and these momenta are combined into a grand total, J. 31. The selection rules for spectroscopic transitions in polyelectronic atoms are: ∆S = 0, ∆L = 0, ±1, ∆l = ±1, ∆J = 0, ±1, but J = 0 ←|→J = 0. Further reading Articles and texts P.W. Atkins, Quanta: a handbook of concepts. Oxford University Press (1991). P.F. Bernath, Spectra of atoms and molecules. Oxford University Press (1995). K. Bonin and W. Happer, Atomic spectroscopy. In Encyclopedia of applied physics (ed. G.L. Trigg), 2, 245. VCH, New York (1991). E.U. Condon and H. Odabaçi, Atomic structure. Cambridge University Press (1980). C.W. Haigh, The theory of atomic spectroscopy: jj coupling, intermediate coupling, and configuration interaction. J. Chem. Educ. 72, 206 (1995). C.S. Johnson, Jr. and L.G. Pedersen, Problems and solutions in quantum chemistry and physics. Dover, New York (1986). J.C. Morrison, A.W. Weiss, K. Kirby, and D. Cooper, Electronic structure of atoms and molecules. In Encyclopedia of applied physics (ed. G.L. Trigg), 6, 45. VCH, New York (1993). N. Shenkuan, The physical basis of Hund’s rule: orbital contraction effects. J. Chem. Educ. 69, 800 (1992). L.G. Vanquickenborne, K. Pierloot, and D. Devoghel, Transition metals and the Aufbau principle. J. Chem. Educ. 71, 469 (1994). Sources of data and information S. Bashkin and J.O. Stonor, Jr., Atomic energy levels and Grotrian diagrams. North-Holland, Amsterdam (1975–1982). D.R. Lide (ed.), CRC handbook of chemistry and physics, Section 10, CRC Press, Boca Raton (2000). Further information Further information 10.1 The separation of motion The separation of internal and external motion Consider a one-dimensional system in which the potential energy depends only on the separation of the two particles. The total energy is E = + + V where p1 = m1R1 and p2 = m2R2, the dot signifying differentiation with respect to time. The centre of mass (Fig. 10.35) is located at X = x1 + x2 m = m1 + m2 and the separation of the particles is x = x1 − x2. It follows that x1 = X + x x2 = X − x The linear momenta of the particles can be expressed in terms of the rates of change of x and X: m1 m m2 m m2 m m1 m p2 2 2m2 p2 1 2m1 p1 = m1R1 = m1| + R p2 = m2R2 = m2| − R Then it follows that + = 1–2m|2 + 1–2µR2 where µ is given in eqn 10.6. By writing P = m| for the linear momentum of the system as a whole and defining p as µR, we find p2 2 2m2 p2 1 2m1 m1m2 m m1m2 m x1 m1 x2 m2 X x Fig. 10.35 The coordinates used for discussing the separation of the relative motion of two particles from the motion of the centre of mass. 358 10 ATOMIC STRUCTURE AND ATOMIC SPECTRA E = + + V The corresponding hamiltonian (generalized to three dimensions) is therefore @ = − ∇2 c.m. − ∇2 + V where the first term differentiates with respect to the centre of mass coordinates and the second with respect to the relative coordinates. Now we write the overall wavefunction as the product ψtotal = ψc.m.ψ, where the first factor is a function of only the centre of mass coordinates and the second is a function of only the relative coordinates. The overall Schrödinger equation, Hψtotal = Etotalψtotal, then separates by the argument that we have used in Sections 9.2a and 9.7, with Etotal = Ec.m. + E. The separation of angular and radial motion The laplacian in three dimensions is given in eqn 9.51a. It follows that the Schrödinger equation in eqn 10.6 is $2 2µ $2 2m p2 2µ P2 2m − + + Λ2 RY + VRY = ERY Because R depends only on r and Y depends only on the angular coordinates, this equation becomes − Y + + Λ2 Y + VRY = ERY If we multiply through by r2 /RY, we obtain − r2 + 2r + Vr2 − Λ2 Y = Er2 At this point we employ the usual argument. The term in Y is the only one that depends on the angular variables, so it must be a constant. When we write this constant as $2 l(l + 1)/2µ, eqn 10.10 follows immediately. $2 2µY D E F dR dr d2 R dr2 A B C $2 2µR D E F R r2 dR dr 2Y r d2 R dr2 A B C $2 2µ D E F 1 r2 ∂ ∂r 2 r ∂2 ∂r2 A B C $2 2µ Discussion questions 10.1 Describe the separation of variables procedure as it is applied to simplify the description of a hydrogenic atom free to move through space. 10.2 List and describe the significance of the quantum numbers needed to specify the internal state of a hydrogenic atom. 10.3 Specify and account for the selection rules for transitions in hydrogenic atoms. 10.4 Explain the significance of (a) a boundary surface and (b) the radial distribution function for hydrogenic orbitals. 10.5 Outline the electron configurations of many-electron atoms in terms of their location in the periodic table. 10.6 Describe and account for the variation of first ionization energies along Period 2 of the periodic table. 10.7 Describe the orbital approximation for the wavefunction of a manyelectron atom. What are the limitations of the approximation? 10.8 Explain the origin of spin–orbit coupling and how it affects the appearance of a spectrum. Exercises 10.1a When ultraviolet radiation of wavelength 58.4 nm from a helium lamp is directed on to a sample of krypton, electrons are ejected with a speed of 1.59 Mm s−1 . Calculate the ionization energy of krypton. 10.1b When ultraviolet radiation of wavelength 58.4 nm from a helium lamp is directed on to a sample of xenon, electrons are ejected with a speed of 1.79 Mm s−1 . Calculate the ionization energy of xenon. 10.2a By differentiation of the 2s radial wavefunction, show that it has two extrema in its amplitude, and locate them. 10.2b By differentiation of the 3s radial wavefunction, show that it has three extrema in its amplitude, and locate them. 10.3a Locate the radial nodes in the 3s orbital of an H atom. 10.3b Locate the radial nodes in the 4p orbital of an H atom where, in the notation of Table 10.1, the radial wavefunction is proportional to 20 − 10ρ + ρ2 . 10.4a The wavefunction for the ground state of a hydrogen atom is Ne−r/a0. Determine the normalization constant N. 10.4b The wavefunction for the 2s orbital of a hydrogen atom is N(2 – r/a0)e−r/2a0. Determine the normalization constant N. 10.5a Calculate the average kinetic and potential energies of an electron in the ground state of a hydrogen atom. 10.5b Calculate the average kinetic and potential energies of a 2s electron in a hydrogenic atom of atomic number Z. 10.6a Write down the expression for the radial distribution function of a 2s electron in a hydrogenic atom and determine the radius at which the electron is most likely to be found. 10.6b Write down the expression for the radial distribution function of a 3s electron in a hydrogenic atom and determine the radius at which the electron is most likely to be found. 10.7a Write down the expression for the radial distribution function of a 2p electron in a hydrogenic atom and determine the radius at which the electron is most likely to be found. PROBLEMS 359 10.7b Write down the expression for the radial distribution function of a 3p electron in a hydrogenic atom and determine the radius at which the electron is most likely to be found. 10.8a What is the orbital angular momentum of an electron in the orbitals (a) 1s, (b) 3s, (c) 3d? Give the numbers of angular and radial nodes in each case. 10.8b What is the orbital angular momentum of an electron in the orbitals (a) 4d, (b) 2p, (c) 3p? Give the numbers of angular and radial nodes in each case. 10.9a Calculate the permitted values of j for (a) a d electron, (b) an f electron. 10.9b Calculate the permitted values of j for (a) a p electron, (b) an h electron. 10.10a An electron in two different states of an atom is known to have j = 3 –2 and 1 –2. What is its orbital angular momentum quantum number in each case? 10.10b What are the allowed total angular momentum quantum numbers of a composite system in which j1 = 5 and j2 = 3? 10.11a State the orbital degeneracy of the levels in a hydrogen atom that have energy (a) –hcRH; (b) –1 –9hcRH; (c) –1 –25hcRH. 10.11b State the orbital degeneracy of the levels in a hydrogenic atom (Z in parentheses) that have energy (a) –4hcRatom (2); (b) −1 –4hcRatom (4), and (c) –hcRatom (5). 10.12a What information does the term symbol 1 D2 provide about the angular momentum of an atom? 10.12b What information does the term symbol 3 F4 provide about the angular momentum of an atom? 10.13a At what radius does the probability of finding an electron at a point in the H atom fall to 50 per cent of its maximum value? 10.13b At what radius in the H atom does the radial distribution function of the ground state have (a) 50 per cent, (b) 75 per cent of its maximum value? 10.14a Which of the following transitions are allowed in the normal electronic emission spectrum of an atom: (a) 2s → 1s, (b) 2p → 1s, (c) 3d → 2p? 10.14b Which of the following transitions are allowed in the normal electronic emission spectrum of an atom: (a) 5d → 2s, (b) 5p → 3s, (c) 6p → 4f? 10.15a (a) Write the electronic configuration of the Ni2+ ion. (b) What are the possible values of the total spin quantum numbers S and MS for this ion? 10.15b (a) Write the electronic configuration of the V2+ ion. (b) What are the possible values of the total spin quantum numbers S and MS for this ion? 10.16a Suppose that an atom has (a) 2, (b) 3 electrons in different orbitals. What are the possible values of the total spin quantum number S? What is the multiplicity in each case? 10.16b Suppose that an atom has (a) 4, (b) 5 electrons in different orbitals. What are the possible values of the total spin quantum number S? What is the multiplicity in each case? 10.17a What atomic terms are possible for the electron configuration ns1 nd1 ? Which term is likely to lie lowest in energy? 10.17b What atomic terms are possible for the electron configuration np1 nd1 ? Which term is likely to lie lowest in energy? 10.18a What values of J may occur in the terms (a) 1 S, (b) 2 P, (c) 3 P? How many states (distinguished by the quantum number MJ) belong to each level? 10.18b What values of J may occur in the terms (a) 3 D, (b) 4 D, (c) 2 G? How many states (distinguished by the quantum number MJ) belong to each level? 10.19a Give the possible term symbols for (a) Li [He]2s1 , (b) Na [Ne]3p1 . 10.19b Give the possible term symbols for (a) Sc [Ar]3d1 4s2 , (b) Br [Ar]3d10 4s2 4p5 . Problems* Numerical problems 10.1 The Humphreys series is a group of lines in the spectrum of atomic hydrogen. It begins at 12 368 nm and has been traced to 3281.4 nm. What are the transitions involved? What are the wavelengths of the intermediate transitions? 10.2 A series of lines in the spectrum of atomic hydrogen lies at 656.46 nm, 486.27 nm, 434.17 nm, and 410.29 nm. What is the wavelength of the next line in the series? What is the ionization energy of the atom when it is in the lower state of the transitions? 10.3 The Li2+ ion is hydrogenic and has a Lyman series at 740 747 cm−1 , 877 924 cm−1 , 925 933 cm−1 , and beyond. Show that the energy levels are of the form –hcR/n2 and find the value of R for this ion. Go on to predict the wavenumbers of the two longest-wavelength transitions of the Balmer series of the ion and find the ionization energy of the ion. 10.4 A series of lines in the spectrum of neutral Li atoms rise from combinations of 1s2 2p1 2 P with 1s2 nd1 2 D and occur at 610.36 nm, 460.29 nm, and 413.23 nm. The d orbitals are hydrogenic. It is known that the 2 P term lies at 670.78 nm above the ground state, which is 1s2 2s1 2 S. Calculate the ionization energy of the ground-state atom. 10.5‡ W.P. Wijesundera, S.H. Vosko, and F.A. Parpia (Phys. Rev. A 51, 278 (1995)) attempted to determine the electron configuration of the ground state of lawrencium, element 103. The two contending configurations are [Rn]5f 14 7s2 7p1 and [Rn]5f 14 6d7s2 . Write down the term symbols for each of these configurations, and identify the lowest level within each configuration. Which level would be lowest according to a simple estimate of spin–orbit coupling? 10.6 The characteristic emission from K atoms when heated is purple and lies at 770 nm. On close inspection, the line is found to have two closely spaced components, one at 766.70 nm and the other at 770.11 nm. Account for this observation, and deduce what information you can. 10.7 Calculate the mass of the deuteron given that the first line in the Lyman series of H lies at 82 259.098 cm−1 whereas that of D lies at 82 281.476 cm−1 . Calculate the ratio of the ionization energies of H and D. 10.8 Positronium consists of an electron and a positron (same mass, opposite charge) orbiting round their common centre of mass. The broad features of the spectrum are therefore expected to be hydrogen-like, the differences arising largely from the mass differences. Predict the wavenumbers of the first three lines of the Balmer series of positronium. What is the binding energy of the ground state of positronium? * Problems denoted with the symbol ‡ were supplied by Charles Trapp, Carmen Giunta, and Marshall Cady. 360 10 ATOMIC STRUCTURE AND ATOMIC SPECTRA 10.9 The Zeeman effect is the modification of an atomic spectrum by the application of a strong magnetic field. It arises from the interaction between applied magnetic fields and the magnetic moments due to orbital and spin angular momenta (recall the evidence provided for electron spin by the Stern–Gerlach experiment, Section 9.8). To gain some appreciation for the socalled normal Zeeman effect, which is observed in transitions involving singlet states, consider a p electron, with l = 1 and ml = 0, ±1. In the absence of a magnetic field, these three states are degenerate. When a field of magnitude B is present, the degeneracy is removed and it is observed that the state with ml = +1 moves up in energy by µBB, the state with ml = 0 is unchanged, and the state with ml = –1 moves down in energy by µBB, where µB = e$/2me = 9.274 × 10−24 J T−1 is the Bohr magneton (see Section 15.1). Therefore, a transition between a 1 S0 term and a 1 P1 term consists of three spectral lines in the presence of a magnetic field where, in the absence of the magnetic field, there is only one. (a) Calculate the splitting in reciprocal centimetres between the three spectral lines of a transition between a 1 S0 term and a 1 P1 term in the presence of a magnetic field of 2 T (where 1 T = 1 kg s−2 A−1 ). (b) Compare the value you calculated in (a) with typical optical transition wavenumbers, such as those for the Balmer series of the H atom. Is the line splitting caused by the normal Zeeman effect relatively small or relatively large? 10.10 In 1976 it was mistakenly believed that the first of the ‘superheavy’ elements had been discovered in a sample of mica. Its atomic number was believed to be 126. What is the most probable distance of the innermost electrons from the nucleus of an atom of this element? (In such elements, relativistic effects are very important, but ignore them here.) Theoretical problems 10.11 What is the most probable point (not radius) at which a 2p electron will be found in the hydrogen atom? 10.12 Show by explicit integration that (a) hydrogenic 1s and 2s orbitals, (b) 2px and 2py orbitals are mutually orthogonal. 10.13‡ Explicit expressions for hydrogenic orbitals are given in Tables 10.1 and 9.3. (a) Verify both that the 3px orbital is normalized (to 1) and that 3px and 3dxy are mutually orthogonal. (b) Determine the positions of both the radial nodes and nodal planes of the 3s, 3px, and 3dxy orbitals. (c) Determine the mean radius of the 3s orbital. (d) Draw a graph of the radial distribution function for the three orbitals (of part (b)) and discuss the significance of the graphs for interpreting the properties of many-electron atoms. (e) Create both xy-plane polar plots and boundary surface plots for these orbitals. Construct the boundary plots so that the distance from the origin to the surface is the absolute value of the angular part of the wavefunction. Compare the s, p, and d boundary surface plots with that of an f-orbital; e.g. ψf ∝ x(5z2 – r2 ) ∝ sin θ (5 cos2 θ – 1)cos φ. 10.14 Determine whether the px and py orbitals are eigenfunctions of lz. If not, does a linear combination exist that is an eigenfunction of lz? 10.15 Show that lz and l2 both commute with the hamiltonian for a hydrogen atom. What is the significance of this result? 10.16 The ‘size’ of an atom is sometimes considered to be measured by the radius of a sphere that contains 90 per cent of the charge density of the electrons in the outermost occupied orbital. Calculate the ‘size’ of a hydrogen atom in its ground state according to this definition. Go on to explore how the ‘size’ varies as the definition is changed to other percentages, and plot your conclusion. 10.17 Some atomic properties depend on the average value of 1/r rather than the average value of r itself. Evaluate the expectation value of 1/r for (a) a hydrogen 1s orbital, (b) a hydrogenic 2s orbital, (c) a hydrogenic 2p orbital. 10.18 One of the most famous of the obsolete theories of the hydrogen atom was proposed by Bohr. It has been replaced by quantum mechanics but, by a remarkable coincidence (not the only one where the Coulomb potential is concerned), the energies it predicts agree exactly with those obtained from the Schrödinger equation. In the Bohr atom, an electron travels in a circle around the nucleus. The Coulombic force of attraction (Ze2 /4πε0r2 ) is balanced by the centrifugal effect of the orbital motion. Bohr proposed that the angular momentum is limited to integral values of $. When the two forces are balanced, the atom remains in a stationary state until it makes a spectral transition. Calculate the energies of a hydrogenic atom using the Bohr model. 10.19 The Bohr model of the atom is specified in Problem 10.18. What features of it are untenable according to quantum mechanics? How does the Bohr ground state differ from the actual ground state? Is there an experimental distinction between the Bohr and quantum mechanical models of the ground state? 10.20 Atomic units of length and energy may be based on the properties of a particular atom. The usual choice is that of a hydrogen atom, with the unit of length being the Bohr radius, a0, and the unit of energy being the (negative of the) energy of the 1s orbital. If the positronium atom (e+ ,e− ) were used instead, with analogous definitions of units of length and energy, what would be the relation between these two sets of atomic units? 10.21 Some of the selection rules for hydrogenic atoms were derived in Justification 10.4. Complete the derivation by considering the x- and ycomponents of the electric dipole moment operator. 10.22‡ Stern–Gerlach splittings of atomic beams are small and require either large magnetic field gradients or long magnets for their observation. For a beam of atoms with zero orbital angular momentum, such as H or Ag, the deflection is given by x = ±(µBL2 /4EK)dB/dz, where µB is the Bohr magneton (Problem 10.9), L is the length of the magnet, EK is the average kinetic energy of the atoms in the beam, and dB/dz is the magnetic field gradient across the beam. (a) Use the Maxwell–Boltzmann velocity distribution to show that the average translational kinetic energy of the atoms emerging as a beam from a pinhole in an oven at temperature T is 2kT. (b) Calculate the magnetic field gradient required to produce a splitting of 1.00 mm in a beam of Ag atoms from an oven at 1000 K with a magnet of length 50 cm. 10.23 The wavefunction of a many-electron closed-shell atom can expressed as a Slater determinant (Section 10.4b). A useful property of determinants is that interchanging any two rows or columns changes their sign and therefore, if any two rows or columns are identical, then the determinant vanishes. Use this property to show that (a) the wavefunction is antisymmetric under particle exchange, (b) no two electrons can occupy the same orbital with the same spin. Applications: to astrophysics and biochemistry 10.24 Hydrogen is the most abundant element in all stars. However, neither absorption nor emission lines due to neutral hydrogen are found in the spectra of stars with effective temperatures higher than 25 000 K. Account for this observation. 10.25 The distribution of isotopes of an element may yield clues about the nuclear reactions that occur in the interior of a star. Show that it is possible to use spectroscopy to confirm the presence of both 4 He+ and 3 He+ in a star by calculating the wavenumbers of the n = 3 → n = 2 and of the n = 2 → n = 1 transitions for each isotope. 10.26‡ Highly excited atoms have electrons with large principal quantum numbers. Such Rydberg atoms have unique properties and are of interest to astrophysicists . For hydrogen atoms with large n, derive a relation for the separation of energy levels. Calculate this separation for n = 100; also calculate the average radius, the geometric cross-section, and the ionization energy. Could a thermal collision with another hydrogen atom ionize this Rydberg atom? What minimum velocity of the second atom is required? Could a normal-sized neutral H atom simply pass through the Rydberg atom leaving it undisturbed? What might the radial wavefunction for a 100s orbital be like? PROBLEMS 361 10.27 The spectrum of a star is used to measure its radial velocity with respect to the Sun, the component of the star’s velocity vector that is parallel to a vector connecting the star’s centre to the centre of the Sun. The measurement relies on the Doppler effect, in which radiation is shifted in frequency when the source is moving towards or away from the observer. When a star emitting electromagnetic radiation of frequency ν moves with a speed s relative to an observer, the observer detects radiation of frequency νreceding = νf or νapproaching = ν/f, where f = {(1 – s/c)/(1 + s/c)}1/2 and c is the speed of light. It is easy to see that νreceding < ν and a receding star is characterized by a red shift of its spectrum with respect to the spectrum of an identical, but stationary source. Furthermore, νapproaching > ν and an approaching star is characterized by a blue shift of its spectrum with respect to the spectrum of an identical, but stationary source. In a typical experiment, ν is the frequency of a spectral line of an element measured in a stationary Earth-bound laboratory from a calibration source, such as an arc lamp. Measurement of the same spectral line in a star gives νstar and the speed of recession or approach may be calculated from the value of ν and the equations above. (a) Three Fe I lines of the star HDE 271 182, which belongs to the Large Magellanic Cloud, occur at 438.882 nm, 441.000 nm, and 442.020 nm. The same lines occur at 438.392 nm, 440.510 nm, and 441.510 nm in the spectrum of an Earth-bound iron arc. Determine whether HDE 271 182 is receding from or approaching the Earth and estimate the star’s radial speed with respect to the Earth. (b) What additional information would you need to calculate the radial velocity of HDE 271 182 with respect to the Sun? 10.28 The d-metals iron, copper, and manganese form cations with different oxidation states. For this reason, they are found in many oxidoreductases and in several proteins of oxidative phosphorylation and photosynthesis (Impact I7.2 and I23.2). Explain why many d-metals form cations with different oxidation states. 10.29 Thallium, a neurotoxin, is the heaviest member of Group 13 of the periodic table and is found most usually in the +1 oxidation state. Aluminium, which causes anaemia and dementia, is also a member of the group but its chemical properties are dominated by the +3 oxidation state. Examine this issue by plotting the first, second, and third ionization energies for the Group 13 elements against atomic number. Explain the trends you observe. Hints. The third ionization energy, I3, is the minimum energy needed to remove an electron from the doubly charged cation: E2+ (g) → E3+ (g) + e− (g), I3 = E(E3+ ) − E(E2+ ). For data, see the links to databases of atomic properties provided in the text’s web site. Molecular structure The concepts developed in Chapter 10, particularly those of orbitals, can be extended to a description of the electronic structures of molecules. There are two principal quantum mechanical theories of molecular electronic structure. In valence-bond theory, the starting point is the concept of the shared electron pair. We see how to write the wavefunction for such a pair, and how it may be extended to account for the structures of a wide variety of molecules. The theory introduces the concepts of σ and π bonds, promotion, and hybridization that are used widely in chemistry. In molecular orbital theory (with which the bulk of the chapter is concerned), the concept of atomic orbital is extended to that of molecular orbital, which is a wavefunction that spreads over all the atoms in a molecule. In this chapter we consider the origin of the strengths, numbers, and three-dimensional arrangement of chemical bonds between atoms. The quantum mechanical description of chemical bonding has become highly developed through the use of computers, and it is now possible to consider the structures of molecules of almost any complexity. We shall concentrate on the quantum mechanical description of the covalent bond, which was identified by G.N. Lewis (in 1916, before quantum mechanics was fully established) as an electron pair shared between two neighbouring atoms. We shall see, however, that the other principal type of bond, an ionic bond, in which the cohesion arises from the Coulombic attraction between ions of opposite charge, is also captured as a limiting case of a covalent bond between dissimilar atoms. In fact, although the Schrödinger equation might shroud the fact in mystery, all chemical bonding can be traced to the interplay between the attraction of opposite charges, the repulsion of like charges, and the effect of changing kinetic energy as the electrons are confined to various regions when bonds form. There are two major approaches to the calculation of molecular structure, valencebond theory (VB theory) and molecular orbital theory (MO theory). Almost all modern computational work makes use of MO theory, and we concentrate on that theory in this chapter. Valence-bond theory, though, has left its imprint on the language of chemistry, and it is important to know the significance of terms that chemists use every day. Therefore, our discussion is organized as follows. First, we set out the concepts common to all levels of description. Then we present VB theory, which gives us a simple qualitative understanding of bond formation. Next, we present the basic ideas of MO theory. Finally, we see how computational techniques pervade all current discussions of molecular structure, including the prediction of chemical reactivity. The Born–Oppenheimer approximation All theories of molecular structure make the same simplification at the outset. Whereas the Schrödinger equation for a hydrogen atom can be solved exactly, an exact solution The Born–Oppenheimer approximation Valence-bond theory 11.1 Homonuclear diatomic molecules 11.2 Polyatomic molecules Molecular orbital theory 11.3 The hydrogen molecule-ion 11.4 Homonuclear diatomic molecules 11.5 Heteronuclear diatomic molecules I11.1 Impact on biochemistry: The biochemical reactivity of O2, N2, and NO Molecular orbitals for polyatomic systems 11.6 The Hückel approximation 11.7 Computational chemistry 11.8 The prediction of molecular properties Checklist of key ideas Further reading Discussion questions Exercises Problems 11 11.1 HOMONUCLEAR DIATOMIC MOLECULES 363 is not possible for any molecule because the simplest molecule consists of three particles (two nuclei and one electron). We therefore adopt the Born–Oppenheimer approximation in which it is supposed that the nuclei, being so much heavier than an electron, move relatively slowly and may be treated as stationary while the electrons move in their field. We can therefore think of the nuclei as being fixed at arbitrary locations, and then solve the Schrödinger equation for the wavefunction of the electrons alone. The approximation is quite good for ground-state molecules, for calculations suggest that the nuclei in H2 move through only about 1 pm while the electron speeds through 1000 pm, so the error of assuming that the nuclei are stationary is small. Exceptions to the approximation’s validity include certain excited states of polyatomic molecules and the ground states of cations; both types of species are important when considering photoelectron spectroscopy (Section 11.4) and mass spectrometry. The Born–Oppenheimer approximation allows us to select an internuclear separation in a diatomic molecule and then to solve the Schrödinger equation for the electrons at that nuclear separation. Then we choose a different separation and repeat the calculation, and so on. In this way we can explore how the energy of the molecule varies with bond length (in polyatomic molecules, with angles too) and obtain a molecular potential energy curve (Fig. 11.1). When more than one molecular parameter is changed in a polyatomic molecule, we obtain a potential energy surface. It is called a potential energy curve because the kinetic energy of the stationary nuclei is zero. Once the curve has been calculated or determined experimentally (by using the spectroscopic techniques described in Chapters 13 and 14), we can identify the equilibrium bond length, Re, the internuclear separation at the minimum of the curve, and the bond dissociation energy, D0, which is closely related to the depth, De, of the minimum below the energy of the infinitely widely separated and stationary atoms. Valence-bond theory Valence-bond theory was the first quantum mechanical theory of bonding to be developed. The language it introduced, which includes concepts such as spin pairing, orbital overlap, σ and π bonds, and hybridization, is widely used throughout chemistry, especially in the description of the properties and reactions of organic compounds. Here we summarize essential topics of VB theory that are familiar from introductory chemistry and set the stage for the development of MO theory. 11.1 Homonuclear diatomic molecules In VB theory, a bond is regarded as forming when an electron in an atomic orbital on one atom pairs its spin with that of an electron in an atomic orbital on another atom. To understand why this pairing leads to bonding, we have to examine the wavefunction for the two electrons that form the bond. We begin by considering the simplest possible chemical bond, the one in molecular hydrogen, H2. The spatial wavefunction for an electron on each of two widely separated H atoms is ψ = χH1sA (r1)χH1sB (r2) if electron 1 is on atom A and electron 2 is on atom B; in this chapter we use χ (chi) to denote atomic orbitals. For simplicity, we shall write this wavefunction as ψ = A(1)B(2). When the atoms are close, it is not possible to know whether it is electron 1 that is on A or electron 2. An equally valid description is therefore ψ = A(2)B(1), in which electron 2 is on A and electron 1 is on B. When two outcomes are equally probable, Comment 11.1 The dissociation energy differs from the depth of the well by an energy equal to the zero-point vibrational energy of the bonded atoms: D0 = De − 1–2$ω, where ω is the vibrational frequency of the bond (Section 13.9). Energy Internuclear separation, RRe -De 0 Fig. 11.1 A molecular potential energy curve. The equilibrium bond length corresponds to the energy minimum. 364 11 MOLECULAR STRUCTURE quantum mechanics instructs us to describe the true state of the system as a superposition of the wavefunctions for each possibility (Section 8.5d), so a better description of the molecule than either wavefunction alone is the (unnormalized) linear combination ψ = A(1)B(2) ± A(2)B(1) (11.1) It turns out that the combination with lower energy is the one with a + sign, so the valence-bond wavefunction of the H2 molecule is ψ = A(1)B(2) + A(2)B(1) (11.2) The formation of the bond in H2 can be pictured as due to the high probability that the two electrons will be found between the two nuclei and hence will bind them together. More formally, the wave pattern represented by the term A(1)B(2) interferes constructively with the wave pattern represented by the contribution A(2)B(1), and there is an enhancement in the value of the wavefunction in the internuclear region (Fig. 11.2). The electron distribution described by the wavefunction in eqn 11.2 is called a σ bond. A σ bond has cylindrical symmetry around the internuclear axis, and is so called because, when viewed along the internuclear axis, it resembles a pair of electrons in an s orbital (and σ is the Greek equivalent of s). A chemist’s picture of a covalent bond is one in which the spins of two electrons pair as the atomic orbitals overlap. The origin of the role of spin is that the wavefunction given in eqn 11.2 can be formed only by a pair of electrons with opposed spins. Spin pairing is not an end in itself: it is a means of achieving a wavefunction (and the probability distribution it implies) that corresponds to a low energy. Justification 11.1 Electron pairing in VB theory The Pauli principle requires the wavefunction of two electrons to change sign when the labels of the electrons are interchanged (see Section 10.4b). The total VB wavefunction for two electrons is ψ(1,2) = {A(1)B(2) + A(2)B(1)}σ(1,2) where σ represents the spin component of the wavefunction. When the labels 1 and 2 are interchanged, this wavefunction becomes ψ(2,1) = {A(2)B(1) + A(1)B(2)}σ(2,1) = {A(1)B(2) + A(2)B(1)}σ(2,1) The Pauli principle requires that ψ(2,1) = −ψ(1,2), which is satisfied only if σ(2,1) = −σ(1,2). The combination of two spins that has this property is σ−(1,2) = (1/21/2 ){α(1)β(2) − α(2)β(1)} which corresponds to paired electron spins (Section 10.7). Therefore, we conclude that the state of lower energy (and hence the formation of a chemical bond) is achieved if the electron spins are paired. The VB description of H2 can be applied to other homonuclear diatomic molecules, such as nitrogen, N2. To construct the valence bond description of N2, we consider the valence electron configuration of each atom, which is 2s2 2px 1 2py 1 2pz 1 . It is conventional to take the z-axis to be the internuclear axis, so we can imagine each atom as having a 2pz orbital pointing towards a 2pz orbital on the other atom (Fig. 11.3), with the 2px and 2py orbitals perpendicular to the axis. A σ bond is then formed by spin pairing between the two electrons in the two 2pz orbitals. Its spatial wavefunction is given by eqn 11.2, but now A and B stand for the two 2pz orbitals. A B(1) (2) A B(2) (1) A B A B(1) (2) + (2) (1) Enhanced electron density Fig. 11.2 It is very difficult to represent valence-bond wavefunctions because they refer to two electrons simultaneously. However, this illustration is an attempt. The atomic orbital for electron 1 is represented by the black contours, and that of electron 2 is represented by the blue contours. The top illustration represents A(1)B(2), and the middle illustration represents the contribution A(2)B(1). When the two contributions are superimposed, there is interference between the black contributions and between the blue contributions, resulting in an enhanced (two-electron) density in the internuclear region. Fig. 11.3 The orbital overlap and spin pairing between electrons in two collinear p orbitals that results in the formation of a σ bond. 11.2 POLYATOMIC MOLECULES 365 The remaining 2p orbitals cannot merge to give σ bonds as they do not have cylindrical symmetry around the internuclear axis. Instead, they merge to form two π bonds. A π bond arises from the spin pairing of electrons in two p orbitals that approach side-by-side (Fig. 11.4). It is so called because, viewed along the internuclear axis, a π bond resembles a pair of electrons in a p orbital (and π is the Greek equivalent of p). There are two π bonds in N2, one formed by spin pairing in two neighbouring 2px orbitals and the other by spin pairing in two neighbouring 2py orbitals. The overall bonding pattern in N2 is therefore a σ bond plus two π bonds (Fig. 11.5), which is consistent with the Lewis structure :N.N: for nitrogen. 11.2 Polyatomic molecules Each σ bond in a polyatomic molecule is formed by the spin pairing of electrons in atomic orbitals with cylindrical symmetry about the relevant internuclear axis. Likewise, π bonds are formed by pairing electrons that occupy atomic orbitals of the appropriate symmetry. The VB description of H2O will make this clear. The valence electron configuration of an O atom is 2s2 2p2 x2p1 y2p1 z. The two unpaired electrons in the O2p orbitals can each pair with an electron in an H1s orbital, and each combination results in the formation of a σ bond (each bond has cylindrical symmetry about the respective O-H internuclear axis). Because the 2py and 2pz orbitals lie at 90° to each other, the two σ bonds also lie at 90° to each other (Fig. 11.6). We can predict, therefore, that H2O should be an angular molecule, which it is. However, the theory predicts a bond angle of 90°, whereas the actual bond angle is 104.5°. Self-test 11.1 Use valence-bond theory to suggest a shape for the ammonia molecule, NH3. [A trigonal pyramidal molecule with each N-H bond 90°; experimental: 107°] Another deficiency of VB theory is its inability to account for carbon’s tetravalence (its ability to form four bonds). The ground-state configuration of C is 2s2 2p1 x2p1 y, which suggests that a carbon atom should be capable of forming only two bonds, not four. This deficiency is overcome by allowing for promotion, the excitation of an electron to an orbital of higher energy. In carbon, for example, the promotion of a 2s electron to a 2p orbital can be thought of as leading to the configuration 2s1 2p1 x2p1 y2p1 z, with four unpaired electrons in separate orbitals. These electrons may pair with four electrons in orbitals provided by four other atoms (such as four H1s orbitals if the molecule is CH4), and hence form four σ bonds. Although energy was required to promote the electron, it is more than recovered by the promoted atom’s ability to form four bonds in place of the two bonds of the unpromoted atom. Promotion, and the formation of four bonds, is a characteristic feature of carbon because the promotion energy is quite small: the promoted electron leaves a doubly occupied 2s orbital and enters a vacant 2p orbital, hence significantly relieving the electron–electron repulsion it experiences in the former. However, we need to remember that promotion is not a ‘real’ process in which an atom somehow becomes excited and then forms bonds: it is a notional contribution to the overall energy change that occurs when bonds form. The description of the bonding in CH4 (and other alkanes) is still incomplete because it implies the presence of three σ bonds of one type (formed from H1s and C2p Internuclear axis Nodal plane Fig. 11.4 A π bond results from orbital overlap and spin pairing between electrons in p orbitals with their axes perpendicular to the internuclear axis. The bond has two lobes of electron density separated by a nodal plane. Fig. 11.5 The structure of bonds in a nitrogen molecule: there is one σ bond and two π bonds. As explained later, the overall electron density has cylindrical symmetry around the internuclear axis. O H H Fig. 11.6 A first approximation to the valence-bond description of bonding in an H2O molecule. Each σ bond arises from the overlap of an H1s orbital with one of the O2p orbitals. This model suggests that the bond angle should be 90°, which is significantly different from the experimental value. 366 11 MOLECULAR STRUCTURE orbitals) and a fourth σ bond of a distinctly different character (formed from H1s and C2s). This problem is overcome by realizing that the electron density distribution in the promoted atom is equivalent to the electron density in which each electron occupies a hybrid orbital formed by interference between the C2s and C2p orbitals. The origin of the hybridization can be appreciated by thinking of the four atomic orbitals centred on a nucleus as waves that interfere destructively and constructively in different regions, and give rise to four new shapes. The specific linear combinations that give rise to four equivalent hybrid orbitals are h1 = s + px + py + pz h2 = s − px − py + pz h3 = s − px + py − pz h4 = s + px − py − pz (11.3) As a result of the interference between the component orbitals, each hybrid orbital consists of a large lobe pointing in the direction of one corner of a regular tetrahedron (Fig. 11.7). The angle between the axes of the hybrid orbitals is the tetrahedral angle, 109.47°. Because each hybrid is built from one s orbital and three p orbitals, it is called an sp3 hybrid orbital. It is now easy to see how the valence-bond description of the CH4 molecule leads to a tetrahedral molecule containing four equivalent C-H bonds. Each hybrid orbital of the promoted C atom contains a single unpaired electron; an H1s electron can pair with each one, giving rise to a σ bond pointing in a tetrahedral direction. For example, the (un-normalized) wavefunction for the bond formed by the hybrid orbital h1 and the 1sA orbital (with wavefunction that we shall denote A) is ψ = h1(1)A(2) + h1(2)A(1) Because each sp3 hybrid orbital has the same composition, all four σ bonds are identical apart from their orientation in space (Fig. 11.8). A hybrid orbital has enhanced amplitude in the internuclear region, which arises from the constructive interference between the s orbital and the positive lobes of the p orbitals (Fig. 11.9). As a result, the bond strength is greater than for a bond formed Comment 11.2 A characteristic property of waves is that they interfere with one another, resulting in a greater displacement where peaks or troughs coincide, giving rise to constructive interference, and a smaller displacement where peaks coincide with troughs, giving rise to destructive interference. The physics of waves is reviewed in Appendix 3. 109.47° Fig. 11.7 An sp3 hybrid orbital formed from the superposition of s and p orbitals on the same atom. There are four such hybrids: each one points towards the corner of a regular tetrahedron. The overall electron density remains spherically symmetrical. C H Fig. 11.8 Each sp3 hybrid orbital forms a σ bond by overlap with an H1s orbital located at the corner of the tetrahedron. This model accounts for the equivalence of the four bonds in CH4. Constructive interference + – + Resultant 2p 2s Destructive interference Fig. 11.9 A more detailed representation of the formation of an sp3 hybrid by interference between wavefunctions centred on the same atomic nucleus. (To simplify the representation, we have ignored the radial node of the 2s orbital.) 11.2 POLYATOMIC MOLECULES 367 from an s or p orbital alone. This increased bond strength is another factor that helps to repay the promotion energy. Hybridization can also be used to describe the structure of an ethene molecule, H2C=CH2, and the torsional rigidity of double bonds. An ethene molecule is planar, with HCH and HCC bond angles close to 120°. To reproduce the σ bonding structure, we promote each C atom to a 2s1 2p3 configuration. However, instead of using all four orbitals to form hybrids, we form sp2 hybrid orbitals: h1 = s + 21/2 py h2 = s + (3 –2)1/2 px − (1 –2)1/2 py h3 = s − (3 –2)1/2 px − (1 –2)1/2 py (11.4) that lie in a plane and point towards the corners of an equilateral triangle (Fig. 11.10). The third 2p orbital (2pz) is not included in the hybridization; its axis is perpendicular to the plane in which the hybrids lie. As always in superpositions, the proportion of each orbital in the mixture is given by the square of the corresponding coefficient. Thus, in the first of these hybrids the ratio of s to p contributions is 1:2. Similarly, the total p contribution in each of h2 and h3 is 3 –2 + 1 –2 = 2, so the ratio for these orbitals is also 1:2. The different signs of the coefficients ensure that constructive interference takes place in different regions of space, so giving the patterns in the illustration. We can now describe the structure of CH2=CH2 as follows. The sp2 -hybridized C atoms each form three σ bonds by spin pairing with either the h1 hybrid of the other C atom or with H1s orbitals. The σ framework therefore consists of C-H and C-C σ bonds at 120° to each other. When the two CH2 groups lie in the same plane, the two electrons in the unhybridized p orbitals can pair and form a π bond (Fig. 11.11). The formation of this π bond locks the framework into the planar arrangement, for any rotation of one CH2 group relative to the other leads to a weakening of the π bond (and consequently an increase in energy of the molecule). A similar description applies to ethyne, HC.CH, a linear molecule. Now the C atoms are sp hybridized, and the σ bonds are formed using hybrid atomic orbitals of the form h1 = s + pz h2 = s − pz (11.5) These two orbitals lie along the internuclear axis. The electrons in them pair either with an electron in the corresponding hybrid orbital on the other C atom or with an electron in one of the H1s orbitals. Electrons in the two remaining p orbitals on each atom, which are perpendicular to the molecular axis, pair to form two perpendicular π bonds (Fig. 11.12). Self-test 11.2 Hybrid orbitals do not always form bonds. They may also contain lone pairs of electrons. Use valence-bond theory to suggest possible shapes for the hydrogen peroxide molecule, H2O2. [Each H-O-O bond angle is predicted to be approximately 109° (experimental: 94.8°); rotation around the O-O bond is possible, so the molecule interconverts between planar and non-planar geometries at high temperatures.] Other hybridization schemes, particularly those involving d orbitals, are often invoked in elementary work to be consistent with other molecular geometries (Table 11.1). The hybridization of N atomic orbitals always results in the formation of N hybrid orbitals, which may either form bonds or may contain lone pairs of electrons. For example, sp3 d2 hybridization results in six equivalent hybrid orbitals pointing towards the corners of a regular octahedron and is sometimes invoked to account for the structure of octahedral molecules, such as SF6. (a) (b) Fig. 11.10 (a) An s orbital and two p orbitals can be hybridized to form three equivalent orbitals that point towards the corners of an equilateral triangle. (b) The remaining, unhybridized p orbital is perpendicular to the plane. Fig. 11.11 A representation of the structure of a double bond in ethene; only the π bond is shown explicitly. Fig. 11.12 A representation of the structure of a triple bond in ethyne; only the π bonds are shown explicitly. The overall electron density has cylindrical symmetry around the axis of the molecule. 368 11 MOLECULAR STRUCTURE Molecular orbital theory In MO theory, it is accepted that electrons should not be regarded as belonging to particular bonds but should be treated as spreading throughout the entire molecule. This theory has been more fully developed than VB theory and provides the language that is widely used in modern discussions of bonding. To introduce it, we follow the same strategy as in Chapter 10, where the one-electron H atom was taken as the fundamental species for discussing atomic structure and then developed into a description of manyelectron atoms. In this chapter we use the simplest molecular species of all, the hydrogen molecule-ion, H2 + , to introduce the essential features of bonding, and then use it as a guide to the structures of more complex systems. To that end, we will progress to homonuclear diatomic molecules, which, like the H2 + molecule-ion, are formed from two atoms of the same element, then describe heteronuclear diatomic molecules, which are diatomic molecules formed from atoms of two different elements (such as CO and HCl), and end with a treatment of polyatomic molecules that forms the basis for modern computational models of molecular structure and chemical reactivity. 11.3 The hydrogen molecule-ion The hamiltonian for the single electron in H2 + is H = − ∇2 1 + V V = − + − (11.6) where rA1 and rB1 are the distances of the electron from the two nuclei (1) and R is the distance between the two nuclei. In the expression for V, the first two terms in parentheses are the attractive contribution from the interaction between the electron and the nuclei; the remaining term is the repulsive interaction between the nuclei. The one-electron wavefunctions obtained by solving the Schrödinger equation Hψ = Eψ are called molecular orbitals (MO). A molecular orbital ψ gives, through D F 1 R 1 rB1 1 rA1 A C e2 4πε0 $2 2me Table 11.1* Some hybridization schemes Coordination number Arrangement Composition 2 Linear sp, pd, sd Angular sd 3 Trigonal planar sp2 , p2 d Unsymmetrical planar spd Trigonal pyramidal pd2 4 Tetrahedral sp3 , sd3 Irregular tetrahedral spd2 , p3 d, dp3 Square planar p2 d2 , sp2 d 5 Trigonal bipyramidal sp3 d, spd2 Tetragonal pyramidal sp2 d2 , sd4 , pd4 , p3 d2 Pentagonal planar p2 d3 6 Octahedral sp3 d2 Trigonal prismatic spd4 , pd5 Trigonal antiprismatic p3 d2 * Source: H. Eyring, J. Walter, and G.E. Kimball, Quantum chemistry, Wiley (1944). rA1 rB1 RA B 1 11.3 THE HYDROGEN MOLECULE-ION 369 (a) (b) Fig. 11.13 (a) The amplitude of the bonding molecular orbital in a hydrogen moleculeion in a plane containing the two nuclei and (b) a contour representation of the amplitude. Exploration Plot the 1σ orbital for different values of the internuclear distance. Point to the features of the 1σ orbital that lead to bonding. Boundary surface Nuclei Fig. 11.14 A general indication of the shape of the boundary surface of a σ orbital. the value of |ψ|2 , the distribution of the electron in the molecule. A molecular orbital is like an atomic orbital, but spreads throughout the molecule. The Schrödinger equation can be solved analytically for H2 + (within the Born– Oppenheimer approximation), but the wavefunctions are very complicated functions; moreover, the solution cannot be extended to polyatomic systems. Therefore, we adopt a simpler procedure that, while more approximate, can be extended readily to other molecules. (a) Linear combinations of atomic orbitals If an electron can be found in an atomic orbital belonging to atom A and also in an atomic orbital belonging to atom B, then the overall wavefunction is a superposition of the two atomic orbitals: ψ± = N(A ± B) (11.7) where, for H2 + , A denotes χH1sA , B denotes χH1sB , and N is a normalization factor. The technical term for the superposition in eqn 11.7 is a linear combination of atomic orbitals (LCAO). An approximate molecular orbital formed from a linear combination of atomic orbitals is called an LCAO-MO. A molecular orbital that has cylindrical symmetry around the internuclear axis, such as the one we are discussing, is called a σ orbital because it resembles an s orbital when viewed along the axis and, more precisely, because it has zero orbital angular momentum around the internuclear axis. Example 11.1 Normalizing a molecular orbital Normalize the molecular orbital ψ+ in eqn 11.7. Method We need to find the factor N such that Ύψ*ψ dτ = 1 To proceed, substitute the LCAO into this integral, and make use of the fact that the atomic orbitals are individually normalized. Answer When we substitute the wavefunction, we find Ύψ*ψ dτ = N2 ΎA2 dτ + ΎB2 dτ + 2ΎAB dτ = N2 (1 + 1 + 2S) where S = ∫AB dτ. For the integral to be equal to 1, we require N = In H2 + , S ≈ 0.59, so N = 0.56. Self-test 11.3 Normalize the orbital ψ− in eqn 11.7. [N = 1/{2(1 − S)}1/2 , so N = 1.10] Figure 11.13 shows the contours of constant amplitude for the two molecular orbitals in eqn 11.7, and Fig. 11.14 shows their boundary surfaces. Plots like these are readily obtained using commercially available software. The calculation is quite straightforward, because all we need do is feed in the mathematical forms of the two atomic orbitals and then let the program do the rest. In this case, we use 1 {2(1 + S)}1/2 5 6 7 1 2 3 370 11 MOLECULAR STRUCTURE A = B = (11.8) and note that rA and rB are not independent (2), but related by the law of cosines (see Comment 11.3): rB = {rA 2 + R2 − 2rAR cos θ}1/2 (11.9) To make this plot, we have taken N2 = 0.31 (Example 11.1). (b) Bonding orbitals According to the Born interpretation, the probability density of the electron in H2 + is proportional to the square modulus of its wavefunction. The probability density corresponding to the (real) wavefunction ψ+ in eqn 11.7 is ψ2 + = N2 (A2 + B2 + 2AB) (11.10) This probability density is plotted in Fig. 11.15. An important feature of the probability density becomes apparent when we examine the internuclear region, where both atomic orbitals have similar amplitudes. According to eqn 11.10, the total probability density is proportional to the sum of 1 A2 , the probability density if the electron were confined to the atomic orbital A. 2 B2 , the probability density if the electron were confined to the atomic orbital B. 3 2AB, an extra contribution to the density. This last contribution, the overlap density, is crucial, because it represents an enhancement of the probability of finding the electron in the internuclear region. The enhancement can be traced to the constructive interference of the two atomic orbitals: each has a positive amplitude in the internuclear region, so the total amplitude is greater there than if the electron were confined to a single atomic orbital. We shall frequently make use of the result that electrons accumulate in regions where atomic orbitals overlap and interfere constructively. The conventional explanation is based on the notion that accumulation of electron density between the nuclei puts the electron in a position where it interacts strongly with both nuclei. Hence, the energy of the molecule is lower than that of the separate atoms, where each electron can interact strongly with only one nucleus. This conventional explanation, however, has been called into question, because shifting an electron away from a nucleus into the internuclear region raises its potential energy. The modern (and still controversial) explanation does not emerge from the simple LCAO treatment given here. It seems that, at the same time as the electron shifts into the internuclear region, the atomic orbitals shrink. This orbital shrinkage improves the electron–nucleus attraction more than it is decreased by the migration to the internuclear region, so there is a net lowering of potential energy. The kinetic energy of the electron is also modified because the curvature of the wavefunction is changed, but the change in kinetic energy is dominated by the change in potential energy. Throughout the following discussion we ascribe the strength of chemical bonds to the accumulation of electron density in the internuclear region. We leave open the question whether in molecules more complicated than H2 + the true source of energy lowering is that accumulation itself or some indirect but related effect. The σ orbital we have described is an example of a bonding orbital, an orbital which, if occupied, helps to bind two atoms together. Specifically, we label it 1σ as it is the σ orbital of lowest energy. An electron that occupies a σ orbital is called a σ electron, and if that is the only electron present in the molecule (as in the ground state of H2 + ), then we report the configuration of the molecule as 1σ1 . e−rB/a0 (πa3 0)1/2 e−rA/a0 (πa3 0)1/2 Comment 11.3 The law of cosines states that for a triangle such as that shown in (2) with sides rA, rB, and R, and angle θ facing side rB we may write: rB 2 = rA 2 + R2 − 2rAR cos θ. rA rB RA B q 2 Fig. 11.15 The electron density calculated by forming the square of the wavefunction used to construct Fig. 11.13. Note the accumulation of electron density in the internuclear region. 11.3 THE HYDROGEN MOLECULE-ION 371 The energy E1σ of the 1σ orbital is (see Problem 11.23): E1σ = EH1s + − (11.11) where S = ΎAB dτ = 1 + + 1 –3 2 e−R/a0 (11.12a) j = Ύ dτ = 1 − 1 + e−2R/a0 (11.12b) k = Ύ dτ = 1 + e−R/a0 (11.12c) We can interpret the preceding integrals as follows: 1 All three integrals are positive and decline towards zero at large internuclear separations (S and k on account of the exponential term, j on account of the factor 1/R). 2 The integral j is a measure of the interaction between a nucleus and electron density centred on the other nucleus. 3 The integral k is a measure of the interaction between a nucleus and the excess probability in the internuclear region arising from overlap. Figure 11.16 is a plot of E1σ against R relative to the energy of the separated atoms. The energy of the 1σ orbital decreases as the internuclear separation decreases from large values because electron density accumulates in the internuclear region as the constructive interference between the atomic orbitals increases (Fig. 11.17). However, at small separations there is too little space between the nuclei for significant accumulation of electron density there. In addition, the nucleus–nucleus repulsion (which is proportional to 1/R) becomes large. As a result, the energy of the molecule rises at short distances, and there is a minimum in the potential energy curve. Calculations on H2 + give Re = 130 pm and De = 1.77 eV (171 kJ mol−1 ); the experimental values are 106 pm and 2.6 eV, so this simple LCAO-MO description of the molecule, while inaccurate, is not absurdly wrong. (c) Antibonding orbitals The linear combination ψ− in eqn 11.7 corresponds to a higher energy than that of ψ+. Because it is also a σ orbital we label it 2σ. This orbital has an internuclear nodal plane where A and B cancel exactly (Figs. 11.18 and 11.19). The probability density is ψ2 − = N2 (A2 + B2 − 2AB) (11.13) There is a reduction in probability density between the nuclei due to the −2AB term (Fig. 11.20); in physical terms, there is destructive interference where the two atomic orbitals overlap. The 2σ orbital is an example of an antibonding orbital, an orbital that, if occupied, contributes to a reduction in the cohesion between two atoms and helps to raise the energy of the molecule relative to the separated atoms. The energy E2σ of the 2σ antibonding orbital is given by (see Problem 11.23) E2σ = EH1s + − (11.14) where the integrals S, j, and k are given by eqn 11.12. The variation of E2σ with R is shown in Fig. 11.16, where we see the destabilizing effect of an antibonding electron. j − k 1 − S e2 4πε0R D F R a0 A C e2 4πε0a0 AB rB e2 4πε0 5 6 7 D F R a0 A C 1 2 3 e2 4πε0R A2 rB e2 4πε0 5 6 7 D F R a0 A C R a0 1 2 3 j + k 1 + S e2 4πε0R Fig. 11.16 The calculated and experimental molecular potential energy curves for a hydrogen molecule-ion showing the variation of the energy of the molecule as the bond length is changed. The alternative g,u notation is introduced in Section 11.3c. Region of constructive interference Fig. 11.17 A representation of the constructive interference that occurs when two H1s orbitals overlap and form a bonding σ orbital. 372 11 MOLECULAR STRUCTURE The effect is partly due to the fact that an antibonding electron is excluded from the internuclear region, and hence is distributed largely outside the bonding region. In effect, whereas a bonding electron pulls two nuclei together, an antibonding electron pulls the nuclei apart (Fig. 11.21). Figure 11.16 also shows another feature that we draw on later: |E− − EH1s| > |E+ − EH1s|, which indicates that the antibonding orbital is more antibonding than the bonding orbital is bonding. This important conclusion stems in part from the presence of the nucleus–nucleus repulsion (e2 /4πε0R): this contribution raises the energy of both molecular orbitals. Antibonding orbitals are often labelled with an asterisk (*), so the 2σ orbital could also be denoted 2σ* (and read ‘2 sigma star’). For homonuclear diatomic molecules, it is helpful to describe a molecular orbital by identifying its inversion symmetry, the behaviour of the wavefunction when it is inverted through the centre (more formally, the centre of inversion) of the molecule. Thus, if we consider any point on the bonding σ orbital, and then project it through the centre of the molecule and out an equal distance on the other side, then we arrive at an identical value of the wavefunction (Fig. 11.22). This so-called gerade symmetry (from the German word for ‘even’) is denoted by a subscript g, as in σg. On the other hand, the same procedure applied to the antibonding 2σ orbital results in the same size but opposite sign of the wavefunction. This ungeradesymmetry (‘odd symmetry’) is denoted by a subscript u, as in σu. This inversion symmetry classification is not applicable to diatomic molecules formed by atoms from two different elements (such as CO) because these molecules do not have a centre of inversion. When using the g,u notation, each set of orbitals of the same inversion symmetry are labelled separately Region of destructive interference Fig. 11.18 A representation of the destructive interference that occurs when two H1s orbitals overlap and form an antibonding 2σ orbital. (b) (a) Fig. 11.19 (a) The amplitude of the antibonding molecular orbital in a hydrogen molecule-ion in a plane containing the two nuclei and (b) a contour representation of the amplitude. Note the internuclear node. Exploration Plot the 2σ orbital for different values of the internuclear distance. Point to the features of the 2σ orbital that lead to antibonding. Fig. 11.20 The electron density calculated by forming the square of the wavefunction used to construct Fig. 11.19. Note the elimination of electron density from the internuclear region. Fig. 11.22 The parity of an orbital is even (g) if its wavefunction is unchanged under inversion through the centre of symmetry of the molecule, but odd (u) if the wavefunction changes sign. Heteronuclear diatomic molecules do not have a centre of inversion, so for them the g, u classification is irrelevant. (a) (b) Fig. 11.21 A partial explanation of the origin of bonding and antibonding effects. (a) In a bonding orbital, the nuclei are attracted to the accumulation of electron density in the internuclear region. (b) In an antibonding orbital, the nuclei are attracted to an accumulation of electron density outside the internuclear region. 11.4 HOMONUCLEAR DIATOMIC MOLECULES 373 so, whereas 1σ becomes 1σg, its antibonding partner, which so far we have called 2σ, is the first orbital of a different symmetry, and is denoted 1σu. The general rule is that each set of orbitals of the same symmetry designation is labelled separately. 11.4 Homonuclear diatomic molecules In Chapter 10 we used the hydrogenic atomic orbitals and the building-up principle to deduce the ground electronic configurations of many-electron atoms. We now do the same for many-electron diatomic molecules by using the H2 + molecular orbitals. The general procedure is to construct molecular orbitals by combining the available atomic orbitals. The electrons supplied by the atoms are then accommodated in the orbitals so as to achieve the lowest overall energy subject to the constraint of the Pauli exclusion principle, that no more than two electrons may occupy a single orbital (and then must be paired). As in the case of atoms, if several degenerate molecular orbitals are available, we add the electrons singly to each individual orbital before doubly occupying any one orbital (because that minimizes electron–electron repulsions). We also take note of Hund’s maximum multiplicity rule (Section 10.4) that, if electrons do occupy different degenerate orbitals, then a lower energy is obtained if they do so with parallel spins. (a) σ orbitals Consider H2, the simplest many-electron diatomic molecule. Each H atom contributes a 1s orbital (as in H2 + ), so we can form the 1σg and 1σu orbitals from them, as we have seen already. At the experimental internuclear separation these orbitals will have the energies shown in Fig. 11.23, which is called a molecular orbital energy level diagram. Note that from two atomic orbitals we can build two molecular orbitals. In general, from N atomic orbitals we can build N molecular orbitals. There are two electrons to accommodate, and both can enter 1σg by pairing their spins, as required by the Pauli principle (see the following Justification). The groundstate configuration is therefore 1σg 2 and the atoms are joined by a bond consisting of an electron pair in a bonding σ orbital. This approach shows that an electron pair, which was the focus of Lewis’s account of chemical bonding, represents the maximum number of electrons that can enter a bonding molecular orbital. Justification 11.2 Electron pairing in MO theory The spatial wavefunction for two electrons in a bonding molecular orbital ψ such as the bonding orbital in eqn 11.7, is ψ(1)ψ(2). This two-electron wavefunction is obviously symmetric under interchange of the electron labels. To satisfy the Pauli principle, it must be multiplied by the antisymmetric spin state α(1)β(2) − β(1)α(2) to give the overall antisymmetric state ψ(1,2) = ψ(1)ψ(2){α(1)β(2) − β(1)α(2)} Because α(1)β(2) − β(1)α(2) corresponds to paired electron spins, we see that two electrons can occupy the same molecular orbital (in this case, the bonding orbital) only if their spins are paired. The same argument shows why He does not form diatomic molecules. Each He atom contributes a 1s orbital, so 1σg and 1σu molecular orbitals can be constructed. Although these orbitals differ in detail from those in H2, the general shape is the same, and we can use the same qualitative energy level diagram in the discussion. There are four electrons to accommodate. Two can enter the 1σg orbital, but then it is full, and the next two must enter the 1σu orbital (Fig. 11.24). The ground electronic configuration Comment 11.4 When treating homonuclear diatomic molecules, we shall favour the more modern notation that focuses attention on the symmetry properties of the orbital. For all other molecules, we shall use asterisks from time to time to denote antibonding orbitals. Fig. 11.23 A molecular orbital energy level diagram for orbitals constructed from the overlap of H1s orbitals; the separation of the levels corresponds to that found at the equilibrium bond length. The ground electronic configuration of H2 is obtained by accommodating the two electrons in the lowest available orbital (the bonding orbital). He1s He1s 2 (1 )u 1 (1 )g s s s s Fig. 11.24 The ground electronic configuration of the hypothetical fourelectron molecule He2 has two bonding electrons and two antibonding electrons. It has a higher energy than the separated atoms, and so is unstable. Comment 11.5 Diatomic helium ‘molecules’ have been prepared: they consist of pairs of atoms held together by weak van der Waals forces of the type described in Chapter 18. 374 11 MOLECULAR STRUCTURE of He2 is therefore 1σg 2 1σu 2 . We see that there is one bond and one antibond. Because an antibond is slightly more antibonding than a bond is bonding, an He2 molecule has a higher energy than the separated atoms, so it is unstable relative to the individual atoms. We shall now see how the concepts we have introduced apply to homonuclear diatomic molecules in general. In elementary treatments, only the orbitals of the valence shell are used to form molecular orbitals so, for molecules formed with atoms from Period 2 elements, only the 2s and 2p atomic orbitals are considered. A general principle of molecular orbital theory is that all orbitals of the appropriate symmetry contribute to a molecular orbital. Thus, to build σ orbitals, we form linear combinations of all atomic orbitals that have cylindrical symmetry about the internuclear axis. These orbitals include the 2s orbitals on each atom and the 2pz orbitals on the two atoms (Fig. 11.25). The general form of the σ orbitals that may be formed is therefore ψ = cA2sχA2s + cB2sχB2s + cA2pz χA2pz + cB2pz χB2pz (11.15) From these four atomic orbitals we can form four molecular orbitals of σ symmetry by an appropriate choice of the coefficients c. The procedure for calculating the coefficients will be described in Section 11.6. At this stage we adopt a simpler route, and suppose that, because the 2s and 2pz orbitals have distinctly different energies, they may be treated separately. That is, the four σ orbitals fall approximately into two sets, one consisting of two molecular orbitals of the form ψ = cA2sχA2s + cB2sχB2s (11.16a) and another consisting of two orbitals of the form ψ = cA2pz χA2pz + cB2pz χB2pz (11.16b) Because atoms A and B are identical, the energies of their 2s orbitals are the same, so the coefficients are equal (apart from a possible difference in sign); the same is true of the 2pz orbitals. Therefore, the two sets of orbitals have the form χA2s ± χB2s and χA2pz ± χB2pz . The 2s orbitals on the two atoms overlap to give a bonding and an antibonding σ orbital (1σg and 1σu, respectively) in exactly the same way as we have already seen for 1s orbitals. The two 2pz orbitals directed along the internuclear axis overlap strongly. They may interfere either constructively or destructively, and give a bonding or antibonding σ orbital, respectively (Fig. 11.26). These two σ orbitals are labelled 2σg and 2σu, respectively. In general, note how the numbering follows the order of increasing energy. (b) π orbitals Now consider the 2px and 2py orbitals of each atom. These orbitals are perpendicular to the internuclear axis and may overlap broadside-on. This overlap may be constructive or destructive, and results in a bonding or an antibonding π orbital (Fig. 11.27). The notation π is the analogue of p in atoms, for when viewed along the axis of the molecule, a π orbital looks like a p orbital, and has one unit of orbital angular momentum around the internuclear axis. The two 2px orbitals overlap to give a bonding and antibonding πx orbital, and the two 2py orbitals overlap to give two πy orbitals. The πx and πy bonding orbitals are degenerate; so too are their antibonding partners. We also see from Fig. 11.27 that a bonding π orbital has odd parity and is denoted πu and an antibonding π orbital has even parity, denoted πg. u g Centre of inversion + + + + - - p p 2s 2s 2pz 2pz A B Fig. 11.25 According to molecular orbital theory, σ orbitals are built from all orbitals that have the appropriate symmetry. In homonuclear diatomic molecules of Period 2, that means that two 2s and two 2pz orbitals should be used. From these four orbitals, four molecular orbitals can be built. 3 (2 )g 4 (2 )us s s s Fig. 11.26 A representation of the composition of bonding and antibonding σ orbitals built from the overlap of p orbitals. These illustrations are schematic. Fig. 11.27 A schematic representation of the structure of π bonding and antibonding molecular orbitals. The figure also shows that the bonding π orbital has odd parity, whereas the antiboding π orbital has even parity. Comment 11.6 Note that we number only the molecular orbitals formed from atomic orbitals in the valence shell. In an alternative system of notation, 1σg and 1σu are used to designate the molecular orbitals formed from the core 1s orbitals of the atoms; the orbitals we are considering would then be labelled starting from 2. 11.4 HOMONUCLEAR DIATOMIC MOLECULES 375 (c) The overlap integral The extent to which two atomic orbitals on different atoms overlap is measured by the overlap integral, S: S = ΎχA*χB dτ [11.17] If the atomic orbital χA on A is small wherever the orbital χB on B is large, or vice versa, then the product of their amplitudes is everywhere small and the integral—the sum of these products—is small (Fig. 11.28). If χA and χB are simultaneously large in some region of space, then S may be large. If the two normalized atomic orbitals are identical (for instance, 1s orbitals on the same nucleus), then S = 1. In some cases, simple formulas can be given for overlap integrals and the variation of S with bond length plotted (Fig. 11.29). It follows that S = 0.59 for two H1s orbitals at the equilibrium bond length in H2 + , which is an unusually large value. Typical values for orbitals with n = 2 are in the range 0.2 to 0.3. Now consider the arrangement in which an s orbital is superimposed on a px orbital of a different atom (Fig. 11.30). The integral over the region where the product of orbitals is positive exactly cancels the integral over the region where the product of orbitals is negative, so overall S = 0 exactly. Therefore, there is no net overlap between the s and p orbitals in this arrangement. (d) The electronic structures of homonuclear diatomic molecules To construct the molecular orbital energy level diagram for Period 2 homonuclear diatomic molecules, we form eight molecular orbitals from the eight valence shell orbitals (four from each atom). In some cases, π orbitals are less strongly bonding than σ orbitals because their maximum overlap occurs off-axis. This relative weakness suggests that the molecular orbital energy level diagram ought to be as shown in Fig. 11.31. However, we must remember that we have assumed that 2s and 2pz orbitals (a) (b) Fig. 11.28 (a) When two orbitals are on atoms that are far apart, the wavefunctions are small where they overlap, so S is small. (b) When the atoms are closer, both orbitals have significant amplitudes where they overlap, and S may approach 1. Note that S will decrease again as the two atoms approach more closely than shown here, because the region of negative amplitude of the p orbital starts to overlap the positive overlap of the s orbital. When the centres of the atoms coincide, S = 0. 0 0 2 4 6 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1 S R a/ 0 Fig. 11.29 The overlap integral, S, between two H1s orbitals as a function of their separation R. + Fig. 11.30 A p orbital in the orientation shown here has zero net overlap (S = 0) with the s orbital at all internuclear separations. 2p 2p 2s 2s 1 g 1 u 2 g 2 u 1 u 1 g Atom Molecule Atom s s s s p p Fig. 11.31 The molecular orbital energy level diagram for homonuclear diatomic molecules. The lines in the middle are an indication of the energies of the molecular orbitals that can be formed by overlap of atomic orbitals. As remarked in the text, this diagram should be used for O2 (the configuration shown) and F2. 376 11 MOLECULAR STRUCTURE Li2 Be2 B2 C2 N2 O2 F2 1 g 1 u 2 g 2 u 1 u 1 g s s p s p s Fig. 11.32 The variation of the orbital energies of Period 2 homonuclear diatomics. 2p 2p 2s 2s Atom Molecule Atom 1 g 1 u 2 g 2 u 1 u 1 g s p s p s s Fig. 11.33 An alternative molecular orbital energy level diagram for homonuclear diatomic molecules. As remarked in the text, this diagram should be used for diatomics up to and including N2 (the configuration shown). contribute to different sets of molecular orbitals whereas in fact all four atomic orbitals contribute jointly to the four σ orbitals. Hence, there is no guarantee that this order of energies should prevail, and it is found experimentally (by spectroscopy) and by detailed calculation that the order varies along Period 2 (Fig. 11.32). The order shown in Fig. 11.33 is appropriate as far as N2, and Fig. 11.31 applies for O2 and F2. The relative order is controlled by the separation of the 2s and 2p orbitals in the atoms, which increases across the group. The consequent switch in order occurs at about N2. With the orbitals established, we can deduce the ground configurations of the molecules by adding the appropriate number of electrons to the orbitals and following the building-up rules. Anionic species (such as the peroxide ion, O2 2− ) need more electrons than the parent neutral molecules; cationic species (such as O2 + ) need fewer. Consider N2, which has 10 valence electrons. Two electrons pair, occupy, and fill the 1σg orbital; the next two occupy and fill the 1σu orbital. Six electrons remain. There are two 1πu orbitals, so four electrons can be accommodated in them. The last two enter the 2σg orbital. Therefore, the ground-state configuration of N2 is 1σg 2 1σu 2 1πu 4 2σg 2 . A measure of the net bonding in a diatomic molecule is its bond order, b: b = 1 –2(n − n*) [11.18] where n is the number of electrons in bonding orbitals and n* is the number of electrons in antibonding orbitals. Thus each electron pair in a bonding orbital increases the bond order by 1 and each pair in an antibonding orbital decreases b by 1. For H2, b = 1, corresponding to a single bond, H-H, between the two atoms. In He2, b = 0, and there is no bond. In N2, b = 1 –2(8 − 2) = 3. This bond order accords with the Lewis structure of the molecule (:N.N:). The ground-state electron configuration of O2, with 12 valence electrons, is based on Fig. 11.31, and is 1σg 2 1σu 2 2σg 2 1πu 4 1πg 2 . Its bond order is 2. According to the building-up principle, however, the two 1πg electrons occupy different orbitals: one will enter 1πu,x and the other will enter 1πu,y. Because the electrons are in different orbitals, they will have parallel spins. Therefore, we can predict that an O2 molecule will have a net spin angular momentum S = 1 and, in the language introduced in Section 10.7, be in a triplet state. Because electron spin is the source of a magnetic moment, we can go on to predict that oxygen should be paramagnetic. This prediction, which VB theory does not make, is confirmed by experiment. 11.4 HOMONUCLEAR DIATOMIC MOLECULES 377 Comment 11.7 A paramagnetic substance tends to move into a magnetic field; a diamagnetic substance tends to move out of one. Paramagnetism, the rarer property, arises when the molecules have unpaired electron spins. Both properties are discussed in more detail in Chapter 20. Synoptic table 11.2* Bond lengths Bond Order Re/pm HH 1 74.14 NN 3 109.76 HCl 1 127.45 CH 1 114 CC 1 154 CC 2 134 CC 3 120 * More values will be found in the Data section. Numbers in italics are mean values for polyatomic molecules. Synoptic table 11.3* Bond dissociation energies Bond Order D0/(kJ mol−1 ) HH 1 432.1 NN 3 941.7 HCl 1 427.7 CH 1 435 CC 1 368 CC 2 720 CC 3 962 * More values will be found in the Data section. Numbers in italics are mean values for polyatomic molecules. Comment 11.8 Bond dissociation energies are commonly used in thermodynamic cycles, where bond enthalpies, ∆bondH7 , should be used instead. It follows from the same kind of argument used in Justification 10.7 concerning ionization enthalpies, that X2(g) → 2 X(g) ∆bondH7 (T) = De + 3 –2RT To derive this relation, we have supposed that the molar constantpressure heat capacity of X2 is 7 –2R (Molecular interpretation 2.2) for there is a contribution from two rotational modes as well as three translational modes. An F2 molecule has two more electrons than an O2 molecule. Its configuration is therefore 1σg 2 1σu 2 2σg 2 1πu 4 1πg 4 and b = 1. We conclude that F2 is a singly-bonded molecule, in agreement with its Lewis structure. The hypothetical molecule dineon, Ne2, has two further electrons: its configuration is 1σg 2 1σu 2 2σg 2 1πu 4 1πg 2 2σu 2 and b = 0. The zero bond order is consistent with the monatomic nature of Ne. The bond order is a useful parameter for discussing the characteristics of bonds, because it correlates with bond length and bond strength. For bonds between atoms of a given pair of elements: 1 The greater the bond order, the shorter the bond. 2 The greater the bond order, the greater the bond strength. Table 11.2 lists some typical bond lengths in diatomic and polyatomic molecules. The strength of a bond is measured by its bond dissociation energy, De, the energy required to separate the atoms to infinity. Table 11.3 lists some experimental values of dissociation energies. Example 11.2 Judging the relative bond strengths of molecules and ions Judge whether N2 + is likely to have a larger or smaller dissociation energy than N2. Method Because the molecule with the larger bond order is likely to have the larger dissociation energy, compare their electronic configurations and assess their bond orders. Answer From Fig. 11.33, the electron configurations and bond orders are N2 1σg 2 1σu 2 1πu 4 2σg 2 b = 3 N2 + 1σg 2 1σu 2 1πu 4 2σg 1 b = 21 –2 Because the cation has the smaller bond order, we expect it to have the smaller dissociation energy. The experimental dissociation energies are 945 kJ mol−1 for N2 and 842 kJ mol−1 for N2 + . Self-test 11.4 Which can be expected to have the higher dissociation energy, F2 or F2 + ? [F2 + ] 378 11 MOLECULAR STRUCTURE X X + hn Orbital i Ii h – Ii EK(e ) n Fig. 11.34 An incoming photon carries an energy hν; an energy Ii is needed to remove an electron from an orbital i, and the difference appears as the kinetic energy of the electron. Detector Electrostatic analyser + - Sample Lamp Fig. 11.35 A photoelectron spectrometer consists of a source of ionizing radiation (such as a helium discharge lamp for UPS and an X-ray source for XPS), an electrostatic analyser, and an electron detector. The deflection of the electron path caused by the analyser depends on their speed. (e) Photoelectron spectroscopy So far we have treated molecular orbitals as purely theoretical constructs, but is there experimental evidence for their existence? Photoelectron spectroscopy (PES) measures the ionization energies of molecules when electrons are ejected from different orbitals by absorption of a photon of the proper energy, and uses the information to infer the energies of molecular orbitals. The technique is also used to study solids, and in Chapter 25 we shall see the important information that it gives about species at or on surfaces. Because energy is conserved when a photon ionizes a sample, the energy of the incident photon hν must be equal to the sum of the ionization energy, I, of the sample and the kinetic energy of the photoelectron, the ejected electron (Fig. 11.34): hν = 1 –2mev2 + I (11.19) This equation (which is like the one used for the photoelectric effect, Section 8.2a) can be refined in two ways. First, photoelectrons may originate from one of a number of different orbitals, and each one has a different ionization energy. Hence, a series of different kinetic energies of the photoelectrons will be obtained, each one satisfying hν = 1 –2mev2 + Ii (11.20) where Ii is the ionization energy for ejection of an electron from an orbital i. Therefore, by measuring the kinetic energies of the photoelectrons, and knowing ν, these ionization energies can be determined. Photoelectron spectra are interpreted in terms of an approximation called Koopmans’ theorem, which states that the ionization energy Ii is equal to the orbital energy of the ejected electron (formally: Ii = −εi). That is, we can identify the ionization energy with the energy of the orbital from which it is ejected. Similarly, the energy of unfilled (‘virtual orbitals’) is related to the electron affinity. The theorem is only an approximation because it ignores the fact that the remaining electrons adjust their distributions when ionization occurs. The ionization energies of molecules are several electronvolts even for valence electrons, so it is essential to work in at least the ultraviolet region of the spectrum and with wavelengths of less than about 200 nm. Much work has been done with radiation generated by a discharge through helium: the He(I) line (1s1 2p1 → 1s2 ) lies at 58.43 nm, corresponding to a photon energy of 21.22 eV. Its use gives rise to the technique of ultraviolet photoelectron spectroscopy (UPS). When core electrons are being studied, photons of even higher energy are needed to expel them: X–rays are used, and the technique is denoted XPS. The kinetic energies of the photoelectrons are measured using an electrostatic deflector that produces different deflections in the paths of the photoelectrons as they pass between charged plates (Fig. 11.35). As the field strength is increased, electrons of different speeds, and therefore kinetic energies, reach the detector. The electron flux canberecordedandplottedagainstkineticenergytoobtainthephotoelectronspectrum. Illustration 11.1 Interpreting a photoelectron spectrum Photoelectrons ejected from N2 with He(I) radiation had kinetic energies of 5.63 eV (1 eV = 8065.5 cm−1 ). Helium(I) radiation of wavelength 58.43 nm has wavenumber 1.711 × 105 cm−1 and therefore corresponds to an energy of 21.22 eV. Then, from eqn 11.20, 21.22 eV = 5.63 eV + Ii, so Ii = 15.59 eV. This ionization energy is the energy needed to remove an electron from the occupied molecular orbital with the highest energy of the N2 molecule, the 2σg bonding orbital (see Fig. 11.33). 11.5 HETERONUCLEAR DIATOMIC MOLECULES 379 H1s F2p 0.98 (H) 0.19 (F)- 0.19 (H) 0.98 (F)+ Ionization limit 13.6eV 13.4eV 18.8eV 18.6eV y y y y Fig. 11.36 The atomic orbital energy levels of H and F atoms and the molecular orbitals they form. Synoptic table 11.4* Pauling electronegativities Element χP H 2.2 C 2.6 N 3.0 O 3.4 F 4.0 Cl 3.2 Cs 0.79 * More values will be found in the Data section. Self-test 11.5 Under the same circumstances, photoelectrons are also detected at 4.53 eV. To what ionization energy does that correspond? Suggest an origin. [16.7 eV, 1πu] 11.5 Heteronuclear diatomic molecules The electron distribution in the covalent bond between the atoms in a heteronuclear diatomic molecule is not shared evenly because it is energetically favourable for the electron pair to be found closer to one atom than the other. This imbalance results in a polar bond, a covalent bond in which the electron pair is shared unequally by the two atoms. The bond in HF, for instance, is polar, with the electron pair closer to the F atom. The accumulation of the electron pair near the F atom results in that atom having a net negative charge, which is called a partial negative charge and denoted δ−. There is a matching partial positive charge, δ+, on the H atom. (a) Polar bonds A polar bond consists of two electrons in an orbital of the form ψ = cAA + cBB (11.21) with unequal coefficients. The proportion of the atomic orbital A in the bond is |cA|2 and that of B is |cB|2 . A nonpolar bond has |cA|2 = |cB|2 and a pure ionic bond has one coefficient zero (so the species A+ B− would have cA = 0 and cB = 1). The atomic orbital with the lower energy makes the larger contribution to the bonding molecular orbital. The opposite is true of the antibonding orbital, for which the dominant component comes from the atomic orbital with higher energy. These points can be illustrated by considering HF, and judging the energies of the atomic orbitals from the ionization energies of the atoms. The general form of the molecular orbitals is ψ = cHχH + cFχF (11.22) where χH is an H1s orbital and χF is an F2p orbital. The H1s orbital lies 13.6 eV below the zero of energy (the separated proton and electron) and the F2p orbital lies at 18.6 eV (Fig. 11.36). Hence, the bonding σ orbital in HF is mainly F2p and the antibonding σ orbital is mainly H1s orbital in character. The two electrons in the bonding orbital are most likely to be found in the F2p orbital, so there is a partial negative charge on the F atom and a partial positive charge on the H atom. (b) Electronegativity The charge distribution in bonds is commonly discussed in terms of the electronegativity, χ, of the elements involved (there should be little danger of confusing this use of χ with its use to denote an atomic orbital, which is another common convention). The electronegativity is a parameter introduced by Linus Pauling as a measure of the power of an atom to attract electrons to itself when it is part of a compound. Pauling used valence-bond arguments to suggest that an appropriate numerical scale of electronegativities could be defined in terms of bond dissociation energies, D, in electronvolts and proposed that the difference in electronegativities could be expressed as |χA − χB| = 0.102{D(A-B) − 1 –2[D(A-A) + D(B-B)]}1/2 [11.23] Electronegativities based on this definition are called Pauling electronegativities. A list of Pauling electronegativities is given in Table 11.4. The most electronegative 380 11 MOLECULAR STRUCTURE elements are those close to fluorine; the least are those close to caesium. It is found that the greater the difference in electronegativities, the greater the polar character of the bond. The difference for HF, for instance, is 1.78; a C-H bond, which is commonly regarded as almost nonpolar, has an electronegativity difference of 0.51. The spectroscopist Robert Mulliken proposed an alternative definition of electronegativity. He argued that an element is likely to be highly electronegative if it has a high ionization energy (so it will not release electrons readily) and a high electron affinity (so it is energetically favorable to acquire electrons). The Mulliken electronegativity scale is therefore based on the definition χM = 1 –2(I + Eea) [11.24] where I is the ionization energy of the element and Eea is its electron affinity (both in electronvolts, Section 10.4e). The Mulliken and Pauling scales are approximately in line with each other. A reasonably reliable conversion between the two is χP = 1.35χM 1/2 − 1.37. (c) The variation principle A more systematic way of discussing bond polarity and finding the coefficients in the linear combinations used to build molecular orbitals is provided by the variation principle: If an arbitrary wavefunction is used to calculate the energy, the value calculated is never less than the true energy. This principle is the basis of all modern molecular structure calculations (Section 11.7). The arbitrary wavefunction is called the trial wavefunction. The principle implies that, if we vary the coefficients in the trial wavefunction until the lowest energy is achieved (by evaluating the expectation value of the hamiltonian for each wavefunction), then those coefficients will be the best. We might get a lower energy if we use a more complicated wavefunction (for example, by taking a linear combination of several atomic orbitals on each atom), but we shall have the optimum (minimum energy) molecular orbital that can be built from the chosen basis set, the given set of atomic orbitals. The method can be illustrated by the trial wavefunction in eqn 11.21. We show in the Justification below that the coefficients are given by the solutions of the two secular equations (αA − E)cA + (β − ES)cB = 0 (11.25a) (β − ES)cA + (αB − E)cB = 0 (11.25b) The parameter α is called a Coulomb integral. It is negative and can be interpreted as the energy of the electron when it occupies A (for αA) or B (for αB). In a homonuclear diatomic molecule, αA = αB. The parameter β is called a resonance integral (for classical reasons). It vanishes when the orbitals do not overlap, and at equilibrium bond lengths it is normally negative. Justification 11.3 The variation principle applied to a heteronuclear diatomic molecule The trial wavefunction in eqn 11.21 is real but not normalized because at this stage the coefficients can take arbitrary values. Therefore, we can write ψ* = ψ but do not assume that ∫ψ2 dτ = 1. The energy of the trial wavefunction is the expectation value of the energy operator (the hamiltonian, @, Section 8.5): Comment 11.9 The name ‘secular’ is derived from the Latin word for age or generation. The term comes via astronomy, where the same equations appear in connection with slowly accumulating modifications of planetary orbits. 11.5 HETERONUCLEAR DIATOMIC MOLECULES 381 E = (11.26) We must search for values of the coefficients in the trial function that minimize the value of E. This is a standard problem in calculus, and is solved by finding the coefficients for which = 0 = 0 The first step is to express the two integrals in terms of the coefficients. The denominator is Ύψ2 dτ = Ύ(cAA + cBB)2 dτ = cA 2 ΎA2 dτ + cB 2 ΎB2 dτ + 2cAcBΎAB dτ = cA 2 + cB 2 + 2cAcBS because the individual atomic orbitals are normalized and the third integral is the overlap integral S (eqn 11.17). The numerator is Ύψ@ψ dτ = Ύ(cAA + cBB)@(cAA + cBB) dτ = cA 2 ΎA@A dτ + cB 2 ΎB@B dτ + cAcBΎA@B dτ + cAcBΎB@A dτ There are some complicated integrals in this expression, but we can combine them all into the parameters αA = ΎA@A dτ αB = ΎB@B dτ [11.27] β = ΎA@B dτ = ΎB@A dτ (by the hermiticity of @) Then Ύψ@ψ dτ = cA 2 αA + cB 2 αB + 2cAcBβ The complete expression for E is E = (11.28) Its minimum is found by differentiation with respect to the two coefficients and setting the results equal to 0. After a bit of work, we obtain = = 0 = = 0 2 × (cBαB − cBE + cAβ − cASE) cA 2 + cB 2 + 2cAcBS ∂E ∂cB 2 × (cAαA − cAE + cBβ − cBSE) cA 2 + cB 2 + 2cAcBS ∂E ∂cA cA 2 αA + cB 2 αB + 2cAcBβ cA 2 + cB 2 + 2cAcBS ∂E ∂cB ∂E ∂cA Ύψ*@ψdτ Ύψ*ψdτ 382 11 MOLECULAR STRUCTURE Comment 11.10 We need to know that a 2 × 2 determinant expands as follows: a b c d = ad − bc For the derivatives to vanish, the numerators of the expressions above must vanish. That is, we must find values of cA and cB that satisfy the conditions cAαA − cAE + cBβ − cBSE = (αA − E)cA + (β − ES)cB = 0 cAβ − cASE + cBαB − cBE = (β − ES)cA + (αB − E)cB = 0 which are the secular equations (eqn 11.25). To solve the secular equations for the coefficients we need to know the energy E of the orbital. As for any set of simultaneous equations, the secular equations have a solution if the secular determinant, the determinant of the coefficients, is zero; that is, if αA − E β − ES (11.29) β − ES αB − E = 0 This determinant expands to a quadratic equation in E (see Illustration 11.2). Its two roots give the energies of the bonding and antibonding molecular orbitals formed from the atomic orbitals and, according to the variation principle, the lower root is the best energy achievable with the given basis set. Illustration 11.2 Using the variation principle (1) To find the energies E of the bonding and antibonding orbitals of a homonuclear diatomic molecule set with αA = αB = α in eqn 11.29 and get α − E β − ES β − ES α − E = (α − E)2 − (β − ES)2 = 0 The solutions of this equation are E± = The values of the coefficients in the linear combination are obtained by solving the secular equations using the two energies obtained from the secular determinant. The lower energy (E+ in the Illustration) gives the coefficients for the bonding molecular orbital, the upper energy (E−) the coefficients for the antibonding molecular orbital. The secular equations give expressions for the ratio of the coefficients in each case, so we need a further equation in order to find their individual values. This equation is obtained by demanding that the best wavefunction should also be normalized. This condition means that, at this final stage, we must also ensure that Ύψ2 dτ = cA 2 + cB 2 + 2cAcBS = 1 (11.30) Illustration 11.3 Using the variation principle (2) To find the values of the coefficients cA and cB in the linear combination that corresponds to the energy E+ from Illustration 11.2, we use eqn 11.28 (with αA = αB = α) to write E+ = = cA 2 α+ cB 2 α + 2cAcBβ cA 2 + cB 2 + 2cAcBS α + β 1 + S α ± β 1 ± S 11.5 HETERONUCLEAR DIATOMIC MOLECULES 383 Now we use the normalization condition, eqn 11.30, to set cA 2 + cB 2 + 2cAcBS = 1, and so write = (c2 A + c2 B)α + 2cAcBβ This expression implies that c2 A + c2 B = 2cAcB = and |cA| = cB = cA Proceeding in a similar way to find the coefficients in the linear combination that corresponds to the energy E−,we write E− = = (c2 A + c2 B)α + 2cAcBβ which implies that c2 A + c2 B = −2cAcB = and |cA| = cB = −cA (d) Two simple cases The complete solutions of the secular equations are very cumbersome, even for 2 × 2 determinants, but there are two cases where the roots can be written down very simply. We saw in Illustrations 11.2 and 11.3 that, when the two atoms are the same, and we can write αA = αB = α, the solutions are E+ = cA = cB = cA (11.31a) E− = cA = cB = −cA (11.31b) In this case, the bonding orbital has the form ψ+ = (11.32a) and the corresponding antibonding orbital is ψ− = (11.32b) in agreement with the discussion of homonuclear diatomics we have already given, but now with the normalization constant in place. The second simple case is for a heteronuclear diatomic molecule but with S = 0 (a common approximation in elementary work). The secular determinant is then = (αA − E)(αB − E) − β2 = 0 The solutions can be expressed in terms of the parameter ζ (zeta), with ζ = 1 –2 arctan (11.33) 2|β| αB − αA β αB − E αA − E β A − B {2(1 − S)}1/2 A + B {2(1 + S)}1/2 1 {2(1 − S)}1/2 α − β 1 − S 1 {2(1 + S)}1/2 α + β 1 + S 1 {2(1 − S)}1/2 1 1 − S α − β 1 − S 1 {2(1 + S)}1/2 1 1 + S α + β 1 + S 384 11 MOLECULAR STRUCTURE Comment 11.11 For x << 1, we can write: sin x ≈ x, cos x ≈ 1, tan x ≈ x, and arctan x = tan−1 x ≈ x. and are E− = αB − β tan ζ ψ− = −A sin ζ + B cos ζ (11.34a) E+ = αA + β tan ζ ψ+ = A cos ζ + B sin ζ (11.34b) An important feature revealed by these solutions is that as the energy difference |αB − αA| between the interacting atomic orbitals increases, the value of ζ decreases. We show in the following Justification that, when the energy difference is very large, in the sense that |αB − αA| >> 2|β|, the energies of the resulting molecular orbitals differ only slightly from those of the atomic orbitals, which implies in turn that the bonding andantibondingeffectsaresmall.Thatis,thestrongestbondingandantibondingeffects are obtained when the two contributing orbitals have closely similar energies. The difference in energy between core and valence orbitals is the justification for neglecting the contribution of core orbitals to bonding. The core orbitals of one atom have a similar energy to the core orbitals of the other atom; but core–core interaction is largely negligible because the overlap between them (and hence the value of β) is so small. Justification 11.4 Bonding and antibonding effects in heteronuclear diatomic molecules When |αB − αA| >> 2|β| and 2|β|/|αB − αA| << 1, we can write arctan 2|β|/|αB − αA| ≈ 2|β|/|αB − αA| and, from eqn 11.33, ζ ≈ |β|/(αB − αA). It follows that tan ζ ≈ |β |/(αB − αA). Noting that β is normally a negative number, so that β /|β| = −1, we can use eqn 11.34 to write E− = αB + E+ = αA − (In Problem 11.25 you are invited to derive these expressions via a different route.) It follows that, when the energy difference between the atomic orbitals is so large that |αB − αA| >> 2|β|, the energies of the two molecular orbitals are E− ≈ αB and E+ ≈ αA. Now we consider the behaviour of the wavefunctions in the limit of large |αB − αA|, when ζ << 1. In this case, sin ζ ≈ ζ and cos ζ ≈ 1 and, from eqn 11.34, we write ψ− ≈ B and ψ+ ≈ A. That is, the molecular orbitals are respectively almost pure B and almost pure A. Example 11.3 Calculating the molecular orbitals of HF Calculate the wavefunctions and energies of the σ orbitals in the HF molecule, taking β = −1.0 eV and the following ionization energies: H1s: 13.6 eV, F2s: 40.2 eV, F2p: 17.4 eV. Method Because the F2p and H1s orbitals are much closer in energy than the F2s and H1s orbitals, to a first approximation neglect the contribution of the F2s orbital. To use eqn 11.34, we need to know the values of the Coulomb integrals αH and αF. Because these integrals represent the energies of the H1s and F2p electrons, respectively, they are approximately equal to (the negative of) the ionization energies of the atoms. Calculate ζ from eqn 11.33 (with A identified as F and B as H), and then write the wavefunctions by using eqn 11.34. Answer Setting αH = −13.6 eV and αF = −17.4 eV gives tan 2ζ = 0.58; so ζ = 13.9°. Then β2 αB − αA β2 αB − αA I11.1 IMPACT ON BIOCHEMISTRY: THE BIOCHEMICAL REACTIVITY OF O2, N2, AND NO 385 E− = −13.4 eV ψ− = 0.97χH − 0.24χF E+ = −17.6 eV ψ+ = 0.24χH + 0.97χF Notice how the lower energy orbital (the one with energy −17.6 eV) has a composition that is more F2p orbital than H1s, and that the opposite is true of the higher energy, antibonding orbital. Self-test 11.6 The ionization energy of Cl is 13.1 eV; find the form and energies of the σ orbitals in the HCl molecule using β = −1.0 eV. [E− = −12.8 eV, ψ− = −0.62χH + 0.79χCl; E+ = −13.9 eV, ψ+ = 0.79χH + 0.62χCl] IMPACT ON BIOCHEMISTRY I11.1 The biochemical reactivity of O2, N2, and NO We can now see how some of these concepts are applied to diatomic molecules that play a vital biochemical role. At sea level, air contains approximately 23.1 per cent O2 and 75.5 per cent N2 by mass. Molecular orbital theory predicts—correctly—that O2 has unpaired electron spins and, consequently, is a reactive component of the Earth’s atmosphere; its most important biological role is as an oxidizing agent. By contrast N2, the major component of the air we breathe, is so stable (on account of the triple bond connecting the atoms) and unreactive that nitrogen fixation, the reduction of atmospheric N2 to NH3, is among the most thermodynamically demanding of biochemical reactions, in the sense that it requires a great deal of energy derived from metabolism. So taxing is the process that only certain bacteria and archaea are capable of carrying it out, making nitrogen available first to plants and other microorganisms in the form of ammonia. Only after incorporation into amino acids by plants does nitrogen adopt a chemical form that, when consumed, can be used by animals in the synthesis of proteins and other nitrogen-containing molecules. The reactivity of O2, while important for biological energy conversion, also poses serious physiological problems. During the course of metabolism, some electrons escape from complexes I, II, and III of the respiratory chain and reduce O2 to superoxide ion, O2 − . The ground-state electronic configuration of O2 − is 1σg 2 1σu 2 2σg 2 1πu 4 1πg 3 , so the ion is a radical with a bond order b = 3 –2. We predict that the superoxide ion is a reactive species that must be scavenged to prevent damage to cellular components. The enzyme superoxide dismutase protects cells by catalysing the disproportionation (or dismutation) of O2 − into O2 and H2O2: 2 O2 − + 2 H+ → H2O2 + O2 However, H2O2 (hydrogen peroxide), formed by the reaction above and by leakage of electrons out of the respiratory chain, is a powerful oxidizing agent and also harmful to cells. It is metabolized further by catalases and peroxidases. A catalase catalyses the reaction 2 H2O2 → 2 H2O + O2 and a peroxidase reduces hydrogen peroxide to water by oxidizing an organic molecule. For example, the enzyme glutathione peroxidase catalyses the reaction 2 glutathionered + H2O2 → glutathioneox + 2 H2O There is growing evidence for the involvement of the damage caused by reactive oxygen species (ROS), such as O2 − , H2O2, and ·OH (the hydroxyl radical), in the mechanism of ageing and in the development of cardiovascular disease, cancer, 386 11 MOLECULAR STRUCTURE stroke, inflammatory disease, and other conditions. For this reason, much effort has been expended on studies of the biochemistry of antioxidants, substances that can either deactivate ROS directly (as glutathione does) or halt the progress of cellular damage through reactions with radicals formed by processes initiated by ROS. Important examples of antioxidants are vitamin C (ascorbic acid), vitamin E (αtocopherol), and uric acid. Nitric oxide (nitrogen monoxide, NO) is a small molecule that diffuses quickly between cells, carrying chemical messages that help initiate a variety of processes, such as regulation of blood pressure, inhibition of platelet aggregation, and defence against inflammation and attacks to the immune system. The molecule is synthesized from the amino acid arginine in a series of reactions catalysed by nitric oxide synthase and requiring O2 and NADPH. Figure 11.37 shows the bonding scheme in NO and illustrates a number of points we have made about heteronuclear diatomic molecules. The ground configuration is 1σ2 2σ2 3σ2 1π4 2π1 . The 3σand 1πorbitals are predominantly of O character as that is the more electronegative element. The highest-energy occupied orbital is 2π, contains one electron, and has more N character than O character. It follows that NO is a radical with an unpaired electron that can be regarded as localized more on the N atom than on the O atom. The lowest-energy occupied orbital is 4σ, which is also localized predominantly on N. Because NO is a radical, we expect it to be reactive. Its half-life is estimated at approximately 1–5 s, so it needs to be synthesized often in the cell. As we saw above, there is a biochemical price to be paid for the reactivity of biological radicals. Like O2, NO participates in some reactions that are not beneficial to the cell. Indeed, the radicals O2 − and NO combine to form the peroxynitrite ion: NO · + O2 − · → ONOO− where we have shown the unpaired electrons explicitly. The peroxynitrite ion is a reactive oxygen species that damages proteins, DNA, and lipids, possibly leading to heart disease, amyotrophic lateral sclerosis (Lou Gehrig’s disease), Alzheimer’s disease, and multiple sclerosis. Note that the structure of the ion is consistent with the bonding scheme in Fig. 11.37: because the unpaired electron in NO is slightly more localized on the N atom, we expect that atom to form a bond with an O atom from the O2 − ion. Molecular orbitals for polyatomic systems The molecular orbitals of polyatomic molecules are built in the same way as in diatomic molecules, the only difference being that we use more atomic orbitals to construct them. As for diatomic molecules, polyatomic molecular orbitals spread over the entire molecule. A molecular orbital has the general form ψ = ∑ i ciχi (11.35) where χi is an atomic orbital and the sum extends over all the valence orbitals of all the atoms in the molecule. To find the coefficients, we set up the secular equations and the secular determinant, just as for diatomic molecules, solve the latter for the energies, and then use these energies in the secular equations to find the coefficients of the atomic orbitals for each molecular orbital. The principal difference between diatomic and polyatomic molecules lies in the greater range of shapes that are possible: a diatomic molecule is necessarily linear, but O2s O2p N2s N2p 1 2 3 4 1 2 Energy s p p s s s Fig. 11.37 The molecular orbital energy level diagram for NO. 11.6 THE HÜCKEL APPROXIMATION 387 a triatomic molecule, for instance, may be either linear or angular with a characteristic bond angle. The shape of a polyatomic molecule—the specification of its bond lengths and its bond angles—can be predicted by calculating the total energy of the molecule for a variety of nuclear positions, and then identifying the conformation that corresponds to the lowest energy. 11.6 The Hückel approximation Molecular orbital theory takes large molecules and extended aggregates of atoms, such as solid materials, in its stride. First we shall consider conjugated molecules, in which there is an alternation of single and double bonds along a chain of carbon atoms. Although the classification of an orbital as σ or π is strictly valid only in linear molecules, as will be familiar from introductory chemistry courses, it is also used to denote the local symmetry with respect to a given A-B bond axis. The π molecular orbital energy level diagrams of conjugated molecules can be constructed using a set of approximations suggested by Erich Hückel in 1931. In his approach, the π orbitals are treated separately from the σ orbitals, and the latter form a rigid framework that determines the general shape of the molecule. All the C atoms are treated identically, so all the Coulomb integrals α for the atomic orbitals that contribute to the π orbitals are set equal. For example, in ethene, we take the σ bonds as fixed, and concentrate on finding the energies of the single π bond and its companion antibond. (a) Ethene and frontier orbitals We express the π orbitals as LCAOs of the C2p orbitals that lie perpendicular to the molecular plane. In ethene, for instance, we would write ψ = cAA + cBB (11.36) where the A is a C2p orbital on atom A, and so on. Next, the optimum coefficients and energies are found by the variation principle as explained in Section 11.5. That is, we have to solve the secular determinant, which in the case of ethene is eqn 11.29 with αA = αB = α: α − E β − ES (11.37) β − ES α − E = 0 The roots of this determinant can be found very easily (they are the same as those in Illustration 11.2). In a modern computation all the resonance integrals and overlap integrals would be included, but an indication of the molecular orbital energy level diagram can be obtained very readily if we make the following additional Hückel approximations: 1 All overlap integrals are set equal to zero. 2 All resonance integrals between non-neighbours are set equal to zero. 3 All remaining resonance integrals are set equal (to β). These approximations are obviously very severe, but they let us calculate at least a general picture of the molecular orbital energy levels with very little work. The assumptions result in the following structure of the secular determinant: 1 All diagonal elements: α − E. 2 Off-diagonal elements between neighbouring atoms: β. 3 All other elements: 0. 388 11 MOLECULAR STRUCTURE These approximations lead to = (α − E)2 − β2 = 0 (11.38) The roots of the equation are E± = α ± β (11.39) The + sign corresponds to the bonding combination (β is negative) and the − sign corresponds to the antibonding combination (Fig. 11.38). We see the effect of neglecting overlap by comparing this result with eqn 11.31. The building-up principle leads to the configuration 1π2 , because each carbon atom supplies one electron to the π system. The highest occupied molecular orbital in ethene, its HOMO, is the 1π orbital; the lowestunfilledmolecularorbital, its LUMO, is the 2π orbital (or, as it is sometimes denoted, the 2π* orbital). These two orbitals jointly form the frontier orbitals of the molecule. The frontier orbitals are important because they are largely responsible for many of the chemical and spectroscopic properties of the molecule. For example, we can estimate that 2|β| is the π* ← π excitation energy of ethene, the energy required to excite an electron from the 1π to the 2π orbital. Theconstantβisoftenleftasanadjustableparameter;anapproximatevalueforπbonds formed from overlap of two C2p atomic orbitals is about −2.4 eV (−230 kJ mol−1 ). (b) The matrix formulation of the Hückel method In preparation for making Hückel theory more sophisticated and readily applicable to bigger molecules, we need to reformulate it in terms of matrices and vectors (see Appendix 2). We have seen that the secular equations that we have to solve for a twoatom system have the form (HAA − EiSAA)ci,A + (HAB − EiSAB)ci,B = 0 (11.40a) (HBA − EiSBA)ci,A + (HBB − EiSBB)ci,B = 0 (11.40b) where the eigenvalue Ei corresponds to a wavefunction of the form ψi = ci,AA + ci,BB. (These expressions generalize eqn 11.25). There are two atomic orbitals, two eigenvalues, and two wavefunctions, so there are two pairs of secular equations, with the first corresponding to E1 and ψ1: (HAA − E1SAA)c1,A + (HAB − E1SAB)c1,B = 0 (11.41a) (HBA − E1SBA)c1,A + (HBB − E1SBB)c1,B = 0 (11.41b) and another corresponding to E2 and ψ2: (HAA − E2SAA)c2,A + (HAB − E2SAB)c2,B = 0 (11.41c) (HBA − E2SBA)c2,A + (HBB − E2SBB)c2,B = 0 (11.41d) If we introduce the following matrices and column vectors H = S = ci = (11.42) then each pair of equations may be written more succinctly as (H − EiS)ci = 0 or Hci = SciEi (11.43) where H is the hamiltonian matrix and S is the overlap matrix. To proceed with the calculation of the eigenvalues and coefficients, we introduce the matrices C = (c1 c2) = E = [11.44] D F 0 E2 E1 0 A C D F c2,A c2,B c1,A c1,B A C D F ci,A ci,B A C D F SAB SBB SAA SBA A C D F HAB HBB HAA HBA A C β α − E α − E β Fig. 11.38 The Hückel molecular orbital energy levels of ethene. Two electrons occupy the lower π orbital. 11.6 THE HÜCKEL APPROXIMATION 389 for then the entire set of equations we have to solve can be expressed as HC = SCE (11.45) Self-test 11.7 Show by carrying out the necessary matrix operations that eqn 11.45 is a representation of the system of equations consisting of eqns 11.41(a)–(d). In the Hückel approximation, HAA = HBB = α, HAB = HBA = β, and we neglect overlap, setting S = 1, the unit matrix (with 1 on the diagonal and 0 elsewhere). Then HC = CE At this point, we multiply from the left by the inverse matrix C−1 , and find C−1 HC = E (11.46) where we have used C−1 C = 1. In other words, to find the eigenvalues Ei, we have to find a transformation of H that makes it diagonal. This procedure is called matrix diagonalization.The diagonal elements then correspond to the eigenvalues Ei and the columns of the matrix C that brings about this diagonalization are the coefficients of the members of the basis set, the set of atomic orbitals used in the calculation, and hence give us the composition of the molecular orbitals. If there are N orbitals in the basis set (there are only two in our example), then there are N eigenvalues Ei and N corresponding column vectors ci. As a result, we have to solve N equations of the form Hci = SciEi by diagonalization of the N × N matrix H, as directed by eqn 11.46. Example 11.4 Finding the molecular orbitals by matrix diagonalization Set up and solve the matrix equations within the Hückel approximation for the πorbitals of butadiene (3). Method The matrices will be four-dimensional for this four-atom system. Ignore overlap, and construct the matrix H by using the Hückel values α and β. Find the matrix C that diagonalizes H: for this step, use mathematical software. Full details are given in Appendix 2. Solution Mathematical software then diagonalizes this matrix to and the matrix that achieves the diagonalization is C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . = − − − − − − ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎜ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ ⎟ ⎟ 0 372 0 602 0 602 0 372 0 602 0 372 0 372 0 602 0 602 0 372 0 372 0 602 0 372 0 602 0 602 0 372 E . . . . = + + − − ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎜ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ ⎟ ⎟ α β α β α β α β 1 62 0 0 0 0 0 62 0 0 0 0 0 62 0 0 0 0 1 62 H = ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎜ ⎜ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ ⎟ ⎟ ⎟ = ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎜ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ ⎟ ⎟ H H H H H H H H H H H H H H H H 11 12 13 14 21 22 23 24 31 32 33 34 41 42 43 44 0 0 0 0 0 0 α β β α β β α β β α 390 11 MOLECULAR STRUCTURE 1.62- 0.62- 0.62+ 1.62+ 4 3 2 1 C2p a a a a b b b b p p p p Fig. 11.39 The Hückel molecular orbital energy levels of butadiene and the top view of the corresponding π orbitals. The four p electrons (one supplied by each C) occupy the two lower π orbitals. Note that the orbitals are delocalized. We can conclude that the energies and molecular orbitals are E1 = α + 1.62β ψ1 = 0.372χA + 0.602χB + 0.602χC + 0.372χD E2 = α + 0.62β ψ2 = 0.602χA + 0.372χB − 0.372χC − 0.602χD E3 = α − 0.62β ψ3 = 0.602χA − 0.372χB − 0.372χC + 0.602χD E4 = α − 1.62β ψ4 = −0.372χA + 0.602χB − 0.602χC − 0.372χD where the C2p atomic orbitals are denoted by χA, . . . , χD. Note that the orbitals are mutually orthogonal and, with overlap neglected, normalized. Self-test 11.8 Repeat the exercise for the allyl radical, · CH2-CH=CH2. [E = α + 21/2 β, α, α − 21/2 β; ψ1 = 1 –2χA + (1 –2)1/2 χB + 1 –2χC, ψ2 = (1 –2)1/2 χA − (1 –2)1/2 χC, ψ3 = 1 –2χA − (1 –2)1/2 χB + 1 –2χC (c) Butadiene and π-electron binding energy As we saw in the preceding example, the energies of the four LCAO-MOs for butadiene are E = α ± 1.62β, α ± 0.62β (11.47) These orbitals and their energies are drawn in Fig. 11.39. Note that the greater the number of internuclear nodes, the higher the energy of the orbital. There are four electrons to accommodate, so the ground-state configuration is 1π2 2π2 . The frontier orbitals of butadiene are the 2π orbital (the HOMO, which is largely bonding) and the 3π orbital (the LUMO, which is largely antibonding). ‘Largely’ bonding means that an orbital has both bonding and antibonding interactions between various neighbours, but the bonding effects dominate. ‘Largely antibonding’ indicates that the antibonding effects dominate. An important point emerges when we calculate the total π-electron binding energy, Eπ, the sum of the energies of each π electron, and compare it with what we find in ethene. In ethene the total energy is Eπ = 2(α + β) = 2α + 2β In butadiene it is Eπ = 2(α + 1.62β) + 2(α + 0.62β) = 4α + 4.48β Therefore, the energy of the butadiene molecule lies lower by 0.48β (about 110 kJ mol−1 ) than the sum of two individual π bonds. This extra stabilization of a conjugated system is called the delocalization energy. A closely related quantity is the π-bond formation energy, the energy released when a π bond is formed. Because the contribution of α is the same in the molecule as in the atoms, we can find the π-bond formation energy from the π-electron binding energy by writing Ebf = Eπ − Nα (11.48) where N is the number of carbon atoms in the molecule. The π-bond formation energy in butadiene, for instance, is 4.48β. Example 11.5 Estimating the delocalization energy Use the Hückel approximation to find the energies of the π orbitals of cyclobutadiene, and estimate the delocalization energy. 11.6 THE HÜCKEL APPROXIMATION 391 C H Fig. 11.40 The σ framework of benzene is formed by the overlap of Csp2 hybrids, which fit without strain into a hexagonal arrangement. b2g e2u e1g a2u Fig. 11.41 The Hückel orbitals of benzene and the corresponding energy levels. The symmetry labels are explained in Chapter 12. The bonding and antibonding character of the delocalized orbitals reflects the numbers of nodes between the atoms. In the ground state, only the bonding orbitals are occupied. Method Set up the secular determinant using the same basis as for butadiene, but note that atoms A and D are also now neighbours. Then solve for the roots of the secular equation and assess the total π-bond energy. For the delocalization energy, subtract from the total π-bond energy the energy of two π-bonds. Answer The hamiltonian matrix is Diagonalization gives the energies of the orbitals as E = α + 2β, α, α, α − 2β Four electrons must be accommodated. Two occupy the lowest orbital (of energy α + 2β), and two occupy the doubly degenerate orbitals (of energy α). The total energy is therefore 4α + 4β. Two isolated π bonds would have an energy 4α + 4β; therefore, in this case, the delocalization energy is zero. Self-test 11.9 Repeat the calculation for benzene. [See next subsection] (d) Benzene and aromatic stability The most notable example of delocalization conferring extra stability is benzene and the aromatic molecules based on its structure. Benzene is often expressed in a mixture of valence-bond and molecular orbital terms, with typically valence-bond language used for its σ framework and molecular orbital language used to describe its π electrons. First, the valence-bond component. The six C atoms are regarded as sp2 hybridized, with a single unhydridized perpendicular 2p orbital. One H atom is bonded by (Csp2 ,H1s) overlap to each C carbon, and the remaining hybrids overlap to give a regular hexagon of atoms (Fig. 11.40). The internal angle of a regular hexagon is 120°, so sp2 hybridization is ideally suited for forming σ bonds. We see that benzene’s hexagonal shape permits strain-free σ bonding. Now consider the molecular orbital component of the description. The six C2p orbitals overlap to give six π orbitals that spread all round the ring. Their energies are calculated within the Hückel approximation by diagonalizing the hamiltonian matrix The MO energies, the eigenvalues of this matrix, are simply E = α ± 2β, α ± β, α ± β (11.49) as shown in Fig. 11.41. The orbitals there have been given symmetry labels that we explain in Chapter 12. Note that the lowest energy orbital is bonding between all neighbouring atoms, the highest energy orbital is antibonding between each pair of neighbours, and the intermediate orbitals are a mixture of bonding, nonbonding, and antibonding character between adjacent atoms. H = ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎜ ⎜ ⎜ ⎜ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ ⎟ ⎟ ⎟ ⎟ ⎟ α β β β α β β α β β α β β α β β β α 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 H = ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎜ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ ⎟ ⎟ α β β β α β β α β β β α 0 0 0 0 392 11 MOLECULAR STRUCTURE We now apply the building-up principle to the π system. There are six electrons to accommodate (one from each C atom), so the three lowest orbitals (a2u and the doublydegenerate pair e1g) are fully occupied, giving the ground-state configuration a2 2ue4 1g. A significant point is that the only molecular orbitals occupied are those with net bonding character. The π-electron energy of benzene is Eπ = 2(α + 2β) + 4(α + β) = 6α + 8β If we ignored delocalization and thought of the molecule as having three isolated π bonds, it would be ascribed a π-electron energy of only 3(2α + 2β) = 6α + 6β. The delocalization energy is therefore 2β ≈ −460 kJ mol−1 , which is considerably more than for butadiene. The π-bond formation energy in benzene is 8β. This discussion suggests that aromatic stability can be traced to two main contributions. First, the shape of the regular hexagon is ideal for the formation of strong σ bonds: the σ framework is relaxed and without strain. Second, the π orbitals are such as to be able to accommodate all the electrons in bonding orbitals, and the delocalization energy is large. 11.7 Computational chemistry The difficulties arising from the severe assumptions of Hückel method have been overcome by more sophisticated theories that not only calculate the shapes and energies of molecular orbitals but also predict with reasonable accuracy the structure and reactivity of molecules. The full treatment of molecular electronic structure is quite easy to formulate but difficult to implement. However, it has received an enormous amount of attention by chemists, and has become a keystone of modern chemical research. John Pople and Walter Kohn were awarded the Nobel Prize in Chemistry for 1998 for their contributions to the development of computational techniques for the elucidation of molecular structure and reactivity. (a) The Hartree–Fock equations The starting point is to write down the many-electron wavefunction as a product of one-electron wavefunctions: Ψ = ψa,α(1)ψa,β(2) . . . ψz,β(N) This is the wavefunction for an N-electron closed-shell molecule in which electron 1 occupies molecular orbital ψa with spin α, electron 2 occupies molecular orbital ψa with spin β, and so on. However, the wavefunction must satisfy the Pauli principle and change sign under the permutation of any pair of electrons. To achieve this behaviour, we write the wavefunction as a sum of all possible permutations with the appropriate sign: Ψ = ψa,α(1)ψa,β(2) . . . ψz,β(N) − ψa,α(2)ψa,β(1) . . . ψz,β(N) + · · · There are N! terms in this sum, and the entire sum can be written as a determinant: (11.50a)Ψ ! ( ) ( ) ( ) ( ) ( ) ( ) ( ) ( ) ( ) , , , , , , , , , = 1 1 1 1 2 2 2 N N N N a a z a a z a a z ψ ψ ψ ψ ψ ψ ψ ψ ψ α β β α β β α β β L L L L M M M M M M L L Comment 11.12 The web site contains links to sites where you may perform semi-empirical and ab initio calculations on simple molecules directly from your web browser. 11.7 COMPUTATIONAL CHEMISTRY 393 The initial factor ensures that the wavefunction is normalized if the component molecular orbitals are normalized. To save the tedium of writing out large determinants, the wavefunction is normally written simply as Ψ = (1/N!)1/2 det|ψa,α(1)ψa,β(2) . . . ψz,β(N)| (11.50b) When the determinantal wavefunction is combined with the variation principle (Section 11.5c), the optimum wavefunctions, in the sense of corresponding to the lowest total energy, must satisfy the Hartree–Fock equations: f1ψa,σ(1) = εψa,σ(1) (11.51) where σ is either α or β. The Fock operator f1 is f1 = h1 + ∑j{2Jj(1) − Kj(1)} (11.52) The three terms in this expression are the core hamiltonian h1 = − ∇2 1 − ∑ n [11.53a] the Coulomb operator J, where Jj(1)ψa(1) = Ύψj*(2)ψj(2) ψa(1)dτ2 [11.53b] and the exchange operator, K, where Kj(1)ψa(1) = Ύψj*(2)ψa(2) ψj(1)dτ2 [11.53c] Although the Hartree–Fock equations look deceptively simple, with the Fock operator looking like a hamiltonian, we see from these definitions that f actually depends on the wavefunctions of all the electrons. To proceed, we have to guess the initial form of the wavefunctions, use them in the definition of the Coulomb and exchange operators, and solve the Hartree–Fock equations. That process is then continued using the newly found wavefunctions until each cycle of calculation leaves the energies and wavefunctions unchanged to within a chosen criterion. This is the origin of the term self-consistent field (SCF) for this type of procedure. The difficulty in this procedure is in the solution of the Hartree–Fock equations. To make progress, we have to express the wavefunctions as linear combinations of M atomic orbitals χi, and write ψa = M ∑ i=1 ciaχi As we show in the Justification below, the use of a linear combination like this leads to a set of equations that can be expressed in a matrix form known as the Roothaan equations: FC = SCε (11.54) where F is the matrix formed from the Fock operator: Fij = Ύχi*(1)f1χj(1)dτ (11.55a) and S is the matrix of overlap integrals Sij = Ύχi*(1)χj(1)dτ (11.55b) D F e2 4πε0r12 A C D F e2 4πε0r12 A C Zne2 4πε0rni $2 2me 394 11 MOLECULAR STRUCTURE Justification 11.5 The Roothaan equations To construct the Roothaan equations we substitute the linear combination of atomic orbitals into eqn 11.51, which gives f1 M ∑ i=1 ciαχi(1) = εα M ∑ i=1 ciαχi(1) Now multiply from the left by χj*(1) and integrate over the coordinates of electron 1: Fji Sji M ∑ i=1 ciα Ύχj(1)* f(1)χi(1)dr1 = εα M ∑ i=1 ciα Ύχj(1)*χi(1)dr1 That is, M ∑ i=1 Fjiciα = εα M ∑ i=1 Sjiciα This expression has the form of the matrix equation in eqn 11.54. (b) Semi-empirical and ab initio methods There are two main strategies for continuing the calculation from this point. In the semi-empirical methods, many of the integrals are estimated by appealing to spectroscopic data or physical properties such as ionization energies, and using a series of rules to set certain integrals equal to zero. In the ab initio methods, an attempt is made to calculate all the integrals that appear in the Fock and overlap matrices. Both procedures employ a great deal of computational effort and, along with cryptanalysts and meteorologists, theoretical chemists are among the heaviest users of the fastest computers. The Fock matrix has elements that consist of integrals of the form (AB|CD) = ΎA(1)B(1) C(2)D(2)dτ1dτ2 (11.56) where A, B, C, and D are atomic orbitals that in general may be centred on different nuclei. It can be appreciated that, if there are several dozen atomic orbitals used to build the molecular orbitals, then there will be tens of thousands of integrals of this form to evaluate (the number of integrals increases as the fourth power of the number of atomic orbitals in the basis). One severe approximation is called complete neglect of differential overlap (CNDO), in which all integrals are set to zero unless A and B are the same orbitals centred on the same nucleus, and likewise for C and D. The surviving integrals are then adjusted until the energy levels are in good agreement with experiment. The more recent semi-empirical methods make less draconian decisions about which integrals are to be ignored, but they are all descendants of the early CNDO technique. These procedures are now readily available in commercial software packages and can be used with very little detailed knowledge of their mode of calculation. The packages also have sophisticated graphical output procedures, which enable one to analyse the shapes of orbitals and the distribution of electric charge in molecules. The latter is important when assessing, for instance, the likelihood that a given molecule will bind to an active site in an enzyme. Commercial packages are also available for ab initio calculations. Here the problem is to evaluate as efficiently as possible thousands of integrals. This task is greatly facilitated by expressing the atomic orbitals used in the LCAOs as linear combinations of D F e2 4πε0r12 A C 5 4 6 4 7 5 4 4 6 4 4 7 11.7 COMPUTATIONAL CHEMISTRY 395 Gaussian orbitals. A Gaussian type orbital (GTO) is a function of the form e−ζr2 . The advantage of GTOs over the correct orbitals (which for hydrogenic systems are proportional to e−ζr ) is that the product of two Gaussian functions is itself a Gaussian function that lies between the centres of the two contributing functions (Fig. 11.42). In this way, the four-centre integrals like that in eqn 11.56 become two-centre integrals of the form (AB|CD) = ΎX(1) Y(2)dτ1dτ2 (11.57) where X is the Gaussian corresponding to the product AB and Y is the corresponding GaussianfromCD.Integralsofthisformaremucheasierandfastertoevaluatenumerically than the original four-centre integrals. Although more GTOs have to be used to simulate the atomic orbitals, there is an overall increase in speed of computation. (c) Density functional theory A technique that has gained considerable ground in recent years to become one of the most widely used techniques for the calculation of molecular structure is densityfunctionaltheory (DFT). Its advantages include less demanding computational effort, less computer time, and—in some cases (particularly d-metal complexes)—better agreement with experimental values than is obtained from Hartree–Fock procedures. The central focus of DFT is the electron density, ρ, rather than the wavefunction ψ. The ‘functional’ part of the name comes from the fact that the energy of the molecule is a function of the electron density, written E[ρ], and the electron density is itself a function of position, ρ(r), and in mathematics a function of a function is called a functional. The exact ground-state energy of an n-electron molecule is E[ρ] = EK + EP;e,N + EP;e,e + EXC[ρ] (11.58) where EK is the total electron kinetic energy, EP;e,N the electron–nucleus potential energy, EP;e,e the electron–electron potential energy, and EXC[ρ] the exchange– correlation energy, which takes into account all the effects due to spin. The orbitals used to construct the electron density from ρ(r) = N ∑ i=1 |ψi(r)|2 (11.59) are calculated from the Kohn–Shamequations, which are found by applying the variation principle to the electron energy, and are like the Hartree–Fock equations except for a term VXC, which is called the exchange–correlation potential: (11.60) The exchange–correlation potential is the ‘functional derivative’ of the exchange– correlation energy: VXC[ρ] = (11.61) The Kohn–Sham equations are solved iteratively and self-consistently. First, we guess the electron density. For this step it is common to use a superposition of atomic δEXC[ρ] δρ − ∇ − + + ⎧ ⎨ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎩ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎫ ⎬ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ ⎭ ⎪ ⎪ ⎪ = = ∑ $2 1 2 2 0 11 2 2 0 12 2 1 1 2 4 4m Z e r e r V j jj N i e XC Kinetic energy Electron–nucleus attraction Electron–electron repulsion Exchange– correlation d 6 74 84 6 74 84 6 74 84 678 ( ) ( ) ( ) π πε ρ ε ψΎ r r r r εε ψi i( )r1 D F e2 4πε0r12 A C G1 G2 G G1 23 y x( ) x Fig. 11.42 The product of two Gaussian functions (the purple curves) is itself a Gaussian function located between the two contributing Gaussians. Comment 11.13 Consider the functional G[f] where f is a function of x. When x changes to x + δx, the function changes to f + δf and the functional changes to G[f + δf]. By analogy with the derivative of a function, the functional derivative is then defined as = lim δf→0 where the manner in which δf goes to zero must be specified explicitly. See Appendix 2 for more details and examples. G[f + δf] − G[f] δf δG δf 396 11 MOLECULAR STRUCTURE electron densities. Then the exchange–correlation potential is calculated by assuming an approximate form of the dependence of the exchange–correlation energy on the electron density and evaluating the functional derivative in eqn 11.61. For this step, the simplest approximation is the local-density approximation and to write EXC[ρ] = Ύρ(r)εXC[ρ(r)]dr (11.62) where εXC is the exchange–correlation energy per electron in a homogeneous gas of constant density. Next, the Kohn–Sham equations are solved to obtain an initial set of orbitals. This set of orbitals is used to obtain a better approximation to the electron density (from eqn 11.59) and the process is repeated until the density and the exchange–correlation energy are constant to within some tolerance. 11.8 The prediction of molecular properties The results of molecular orbital calculations are only approximate, with deviations from experimental values increasing with the size of the molecule. Therefore, one goal of computational chemistry is to gain insight into trends in properties of molecules, without necessarily striving for ultimate accuracy. In the next sections we give a brief summary of strategies used by computational chemists for the prediction of molecular properties. (a) Electron density and the electrostatic potential surfaces One of the most significant developments in computational chemistry has been the introduction of graphical representations of molecular orbitals and electron densities. The raw output of a molecular structure calculation is a list of the coefficients of the atomic orbitals in each molecular orbital and the energies of these orbitals. The graphical representation of a molecular orbital uses stylized shapes to represent the basis set, and then scales their size to indicate the coefficient in the linear combination. Different signs of the wavefunctions are represented by different colours. Once the coefficients are known, we can build up a representation of the electron density in the molecule by noting which orbitals are occupied and then forming the squares of those orbitals. The total electron density at any point is then the sum of the squaresofthewavefunctionsevaluatedatthatpoint.Theoutcomeiscommonlyrepresented by a isodensity surface, a surface of constant total electron density (Fig. 11.43). As shown in the illustration, there are several styles of representing an isodensity surface, as a solid form, as a transparent form with a ball-and-stick representation of the molecule within, or as a mesh. A related representation is a solvent-accessiblesurface in which the shape represents the shape of the molecule by imagining a sphere representing a solvent molecule rolling across the surface and plotting the locations of the centre of that sphere. One of the most important aspects of a molecule other than its geometrical shape is the distribution of charge over its surface. The net charge at each point on an isodensity surface can be calculated by subtracting the charge due to the electron density at that point form the charge due to the nuclei: the result is an electrostaticpotentialsurface (an ‘elpot surface’) in which net positive charge is shown in one colour and net negativechargeisshowninanother,withintermediategradationsofcolour(Fig.11.44). Representations such as those we have illustrated are of critical importance in a number of fields. For instance, they may be used to identify an electron-poor region of a molecule that is susceptible to association with or chemical attack by an electronrich region of another molecule. Such considerations are important for assessing the pharmacological activity of potential drugs. (a) (b) (c) Fig. 11.43 Various representations of an isodensity surface of ethanol (a) solid surface, (b) transparent surface, and (c) mesh surface. Fig. 11.44 An elpot diagram of ethanol. 11.8 THE PREDICTION OF MOLECULAR PROPERTIES 397 (b) Thermodynamic and spectroscopic properties We already saw in Section 2.8 that computational chemistry is becoming the technique of choice for estimating standard enthalpies of formation of molecules with complex three-dimensional structures. The computational approach also makes it possible to gain insight into the effect of solvation on the enthalpy of formation without conducting experiments. A calculation performed in the absence of solvent molecules estimates the properties of the molecule of interest in the gas phase. Computational methods are available that allow for the inclusion of several solvent molecules around a solute molecule, thereby taking into account the effect of molecular interactions with the solvent on the enthalpy of formation of the solute. Again, the numerical results are only estimates and the primary purpose of the calculation is to predict whether interactions with the solvent increase or decrease the enthalpy of formation. As an example, consider the amino acid glycine, which can exist in a neutral (4) or zwitterionic (5) form, in which the amino group is protonated and the carboxyl group is deprotonated. It is possible to show computationally that in the gas phase the neutral form has a lower enthalpy of formation than the zwitterionic form. However, in water the opposite is true because of strong interactions between the polar solvent and the charges in the zwitterion. Molecular orbital calculations can also be used to predict trends in electrochemical properties, such as standard potentials (Chapter 7). Several experimental and computational studies of aromatic hydrocarbons indicate that decreasing the energy of the LUMO enhances the ability of a molecule to accept an electron into the LUMO, with an attendant increase in the value of the molecule’s standard potential. The effect is also observed in quinones and flavins, co-factors involved in biological electron transfer reactions.Forexample,stepwisesubstitutionofthehydrogenatomsinp-benzoquinone by methyl groups (-CH3) results in a systematic increase in the energy of the LUMO and a decrease in the standard potential for formation of the semiquinone radical (6): The standard potentials of naturally occurring quinones are also modified by the presence of different substituents, a strategy that imparts specific functions to specific quinones. For example, the substituents in coenzyme Q are largely responsible for poising its standard potential so that the molecule can function as an electron shuttle between specific electroactive proteins in the respiratory chain (Impact I17.2). We remarked in Chapter 8 that a molecule can absorb or emit a photon of energy hc/λ, resulting in a transition between two quantized molecular energy levels. The transition of lowest energy (and longest wavelength) occurs between the HOMO and LUMO. We can use calculations based on semi-empirical, ab initio, and DFT methods to correlate the calculated HOMO–LUMO energy gap with the wavelength of absorption. For example, consider the linear polyenes shown in Table 11.5: ethene (C2H4), butadiene (C4H6), hexatriene (C6H8), and octatetraene (C8H10), all of which absorb in the ultraviolet region of the spectrum. The table also shows that, as expected, the wavelength of the lowest-energy electronic transition decreases as the energy separation between the HOMO and LUMO increases. We also see that the smallest HOMO– LUMO gap and longest transition wavelength correspond to octatetraene, the longest 398 11 MOLECULAR STRUCTURE polyene in the group. It follows that the wavelength of the transition increases with increasing number of conjugated double bonds in linear polyenes. Extrapolation of the trend suggests that a sufficiently long linear polyene should absorb light in the visible region of the electromagnetic spectrum. This is indeed the case for β-carotene (7), which absorbs light with λ ≈ 450 nm. The ability of β-carotene to absorb visible light is part of the strategy employed by plants to harvest solar energy for use in photosynthesis (Chapter 23). Checklist of key ideas 1. In the Born–Oppenheimer approximation, nuclei are treated as stationary while electrons move around them. 2. In valence-bond theory (VB theory), a bond is regarded as forming when an electron in an atomic orbital on one atoms pairs its spin with that of an electron in an atomic orbital on another atom. 3. A valence bond wavefunction with cylindrical symmetry around the internuclear axis is a σ bond. A π bond arises from the merging of two p orbitals that approach side-by-side and the pairing of electrons that they contain. 4. Hybrid orbitals are mixtures or atomic orbitals on the same atom and are invoked in VB theory to explain molecular geometries. 5. In molecular orbital theory (MO theory), electrons are treated as spreading throughout the entire molecule. 6. A bonding orbital is a molecular orbital that, if occupied, contributes to the strength of a bond between two atoms. An antibonding orbital is a molecular orbital that, if occupied, decreases the strength of a bond between two atoms. 7. A σ molecular orbital has zero orbital angular momentum about the internuclear axis. A π molecular orbital has one unit of angular momentum around the internuclear axis; in a nonlinear molecule, it has a nodal plane that includes the internucelar axis. 8. The electron configurations of homonuclear diatomic molecules are shown in Figs. 11.31 and 11.33. 9. When constructing molecular orbitals, we need to consider only combinations of atomic orbitals of similar energies and of the same symmetry around the internuclear axis. 10. The bond order of a diatomic molecule is b = 1–2(n − n*), where n and n* are the numbers of electrons in bonding and antibonding orbitals, respectively. 11. The electronegativity, χ, of an element is the power of its atoms to draw electrons to itself when it is part of a compound. 12. In a bond between dissimilar atoms, the atomic orbital belonging to the more electronegative atom makes the larger contribution to the molecular orbital with the lowest energy. For the molecular orbital with the highest energy, the principal contribution comes from the atomic orbital belonging to the less electronegative atom. Table 11.5 Ab initio calculations and spectroscopic data Polyene {E(HOMO) − E(LUMO)}/eV λ/nm (C2H4) 18.1 163 14.5 217 12.7 252 11.8 304 EXERCISES 399 13. The hamiltonian matrix, H, is formed of all integrals Hij = ∫ψi*@ψjdτ. The overlap matrix, S, is formed of all Sij = ∫ψi*ψjdτ. 14. The variation principle states that if an arbitrary wavefunction is used to calculate the energy, the value calculated is never less than the true energy. 15. In the Hückel method, all Coulomb integrals Hii are set equal (to α), all overlap integrals are set equal to zero, all resonance integrals Hij between non-neighbours are set equal to zero, and all remaining resonance integrals are set equal (to β). 16. The π-electron binding energy is the sum of the energies of each π electron. The π-bond formation energy is the energy released when a π bond is formed. The delocalization energy is the extra stabilization of a conjugated system. 17. In the self-consistent field procedure, an initial guess about the composition of the molecular orbitals is successively refined until the solution remains unchanged in a cycle of calculations. 18. In semi-empirical methods for the determination of electronic structure, the Schrödinger equation is written in terms of parameters chosen to agree with selected experimental quantities. In ab initio and density functional methods, the Schrödinger equation is solved numerically, without the need of parameters that appeal to experimental data. Further reading Articles and texts T.A. Albright and J.K. Burdett, Problems in molecular orbital theory. Oxford University Press (1992). P.W. Atkins and R.S. Friedman, Molecular quantum mechanics. Oxford University Press (2005). I.N. Levine, Quantum chemistry. Prentice–Hall, Upper Saddle River (2000). D.A. McQuarrie, Mathematical methods for scientists and engineers. University Science Books, Mill Valley (2003). R.C. Mebane, S.A. Schanley, T.R. Rybolt, and C.D. Bruce, The correlation of physical properties of organic molecules with computed molecular surface areas. J. Chem. Educ. 76, 688 (1999). L. Pauling, The nature of the chemical bond. Cornell University Press, Ithaca (1960). C.M. Quinn, Computational quantum chemistry: an interactive guide to basis set theory. Academic Press, San Diego (2002). Sources of data and information D.R. Lide (ed.), CRC handbook of chemistry and physics, Section 9, CRC Press, Boca Raton (2000). P.R. Scott and W.G. Richards, Energy levels in atoms and molecules. Oxford Chemistry Primers, Oxford University Press (1994). Discussion questions 11.1 Compare the approximations built into valence-bond theory and molecular-orbital theory. 11.2 Discuss the steps involved in the construction of sp3 , sp2 , and sp hybrid orbitals. 11.3 Distinguish between the Pauling and Mulliken electronegativity scales. 11.4 Discuss the steps involved in the calculation of the energy of a system by using the variation principle. 11.5 Discuss the approximations built into the Hückel method. 11.6 Distinguish between delocalization energy, π-electron binding energy, and π-bond formation energy. 11.7 Use concepts of molecular orbital theory to describe the biochemical reactivity of O2, N2, and NO. 11.8 Distinguish between semi-empirical, ab initio, and density functional theory methods of electronic structure determination. Exercises 11.1a Give the ground-state electron configurations and bond orders of (a) Li2, (b) Be2, and (c) C2. 11.1b Give the ground-state electron configurations of (a) H2 − , (b) N2, and (c) O2. 11.2a Give the ground-state electron configurations of (a) CO, (b) NO, and (c) CN− . 11.2b Give the ground-state electron configurations of (a) ClF, (b) CS, and (c) O2 − . 400 11 MOLECULAR STRUCTURE 11.3a From the ground-state electron configurations of B2 and C2, predict which molecule should have the greater bond dissociation energy. 11.3b Which of the molecules N2, NO, O2, C2, F2, and CN would you expect to be stabilized by (a) the addition of an electron to form AB− , (b) the removal of an electron to form AB+ ? 11.4a Sketch the molecular orbital energy level diagram for XeF and deduce its ground-state electron configurations. Is XeF likely to have a shorter bond length than XeF+ ? 11.4b Sketch the molecular orbital energy level diagrams for BrCl and deduce its ground-state electron configurations. Is BrCl likely to have a shorter bond length than BrCl− ? 11.5a Use the electron configurations of NO and N2 to predict which is likely to have the shorter bond length. 11.5b Arrange the species O2 + , O2, O2 − , O2 2− in order of increasing bond length. 11.6a Show that the sp2 hybrid orbital (s + 21/2 p)/31/2 is normalized to 1 if the s and p orbitals are normalized to 1. 11.6b Normalize the molecular orbital ψA + λψB in terms of the parameter λ and the overlap integral S. 11.7a Confirm that the bonding and antibonding combinations ψA ± ψB are mutually orthogonal in the sense that their mutual overlap is zero. 11.7b Suppose that a molecular orbital has the form N(0.145A + 0.844B). Find a linear combination of the orbitals A and B that is orthogonal to this combination. 11.8a Can the function ψ = x(L − x) be used as a trial wavefunction for the n = 1 state of a particle with mass m in a one-dimensional box of length L? If the answer is yes, then express the energy of this trial wavefunction in terms of h, m, and L and compare it with the exact result (eqn 9.4). If the answer is no, explain why this is not a suitable trial wavefunction. 11.8b Can the function ψ = x2 (L − 2x) be used as a trial wavefunction for the n = 1 state of a particle with mass m in a one-dimensional box of length L? If the answer is yes, then express the energy of this trial wavefunction in terms of h, m, and L and compare it with the exact result (eqn 9.4). If the answer is no, explain why this is not a suitable trial wavefunction. 11.9a Suppose that the function ψ = Ae−ar2 , with A being the normalization constant and a being an adjustable parameter, is used as a trial wavefunction for the 1s orbital of the hydrogen atom. Express the energy of this trial wavefunction as a function of the h, a, e, the electron charge, and µ, the effective mass of the H atom. 11.9b Suppose that the function ψ = Ae−ar2 , with A being the normalization constant and a being an adjustable parameter, is used as a trial wavefunction for the 1s orbital of the hydrogen atom. The energy of this trial wavefunction is E = − 1/2 where e is the electron charge, and µ is the effective mass of the H atom. What is the minimum energy associated with this trial wavefunction? 11.10a What is the energy of an electron that has been ejected from an orbital of ionization energy 11.0 eV by a photon of radiation of wavelength 100 nm? 11.10b What is the energy of an electron that has been ejected from an orbital of ionization energy 4.69 eV by a photon of radiation of wavelength 584 pm? 11.11a Construct the molecular orbital energy level diagrams of ethene on the basis that the molecule is formed from the appropriately hybridized CH2 or CH fragments. 11.11b Construct the molecular orbital energy level diagrams of ethyne (acetylene) on the basis that the molecule is formed from the appropriately hybridized CH2 or CH fragments. 11.12a Write down the secular determinants for (a) linear H3, (b) cyclic H3 within the Hückel approximation. 11.12b Predict the electronic configurations of (a) the benzene anion, (b) the benzene cation. Estimate the π-electron binding energy in each case. 11.13a Write down the secular determinants (a) anthracene (8), (b) phenanthrene (9) within the Hückel approximation and using the C2p orbitals as the basis set. 11.13b Use mathematical software to estimate the π-electron binding energy of (a) anthracene (7), (b) phenanthrene (8) within the Hückel approximation. D E F a 2π3 A B C e2 ε0 3a$2 2µ Problems* Numerical problems 11.1 Show that, if a wave cos kx centred on A (so that x is measured from A) interferes with a similar wave cos k′x centred on B (with x measured from B) a distance R away, then constructive interference occurs in the intermediate region when k = k′ = π/2R and destructive interference if kR = 1 –2π and k′R = 3 –2π. 11.2 The overlap integral between two H1s orbitals on nuclei separated by a distance R is S = {1 + (R/a0) + 1 –3(R/a0)2 }e−R/a0. Plot this function for 0 ≤ R < ∞. 11.3 Before doing the calculation below, sketch how the overlap between a 1s orbital and a 2p orbital can be expected to depend on their separation. The overlap integral between an H1s orbital and an H2p orbital on nuclei separated by a distance R and forming a σ orbital is S = (R/a0){1 + (R/a0) + 1 –3(R/a0)2 }e−R/a0 . Plot this function, and find the separation for which the overlap is a maximum. 11.4 Calculate the total amplitude of the normalized bonding and antibonding LCAO-MOs that may be formed from two H1s orbitals at a separation of 106 pm. Plot the two amplitudes for positions along the molecular axis both inside and outside the internuclear region. 11.5 Repeat the calculation in Problem 11.4 but plot the probability densities of the two orbitals. Then form the difference density, the difference between ψ2 and 1 –2{ψA 2 + ψB 2 }. * Problems denoted with the symbol ‡ were supplied by Charles Trapp, Carmen Giunta, and Marshall Cady. PROBLEMS 401 11.6‡ Use the 2px and 2pz hydrogenic atomic orbitals to construct simple LCAO descriptions of 2pσ and 2pπ molecular orbitals. (a) Make a probability density plot, and both surface and contour plots of the xz-plane amplitudes of the 2pzσ and 2pzσ* molecular orbitals. (b) Make surface and contour plots of the xz-plane amplitudes of the 2pxπ and 2pxπ* molecular orbitals. Include plots for both internuclear distances, R, of 10a0 and 3a0, where a0 = 52.9 pm. Interpret the graphs, and describe why this graphical information is useful. 11.7 Imagine a small electron-sensitive probe of volume 1.00 pm3 inserted into an H2 + molecule-ion in its ground state. Calculate the probability that it will register the presence of an electron at the following positions: (a) at nucleus A, (b) at nucleus B, (c) half-way between A and B, (c) at a point 20 pm along the bond from A and 10 pm perpendicularly. Do the same for the molecule-ion the instant after the electron has been excited into the antibonding LCAO-MO. 11.8 The energy of H2 + with internuclear separation R is given by the expression E = EH + − where EH is the energy of an isolated H atom, V1 is the attractive potential energy between the electron centred on one nucleus and the charge of the other nucleus, V2 is the attraction between the overlap density and one of the nuclei, S is the overlap integral. The values are given below. Plot the molecular potential energy curve and find the bond dissociation energy (in electronvolts) and the equilibrium bond length. R/a0 0 1 2 3 4 V1/Eh 11.000 10.729 10.473 10.330 10.250 V2/Eh 11.000 10.736 10.406 10.199 10.092 S 1.000 0.858 0.587 0.349 0.189 where Eh = 27.3 eV and a0 = 52.9 pm and EH = −1 –2Eh. 11.9 The same data as in Problem 11.8 may be used to calculate the molecular potential energy curve for the antibonding orbital, which is given by E = EH + − Plot the curve. 11.10‡ J.G. Dojahn, E.C.M. Chen, and W.E. Wentworth (J. Phys. Chem. 100, 9649 (1996)) characterized the potential energy curves of homonuclear diatomic halogen molecules and molecular anions. Among the properties they report are the equilibrium internuclear distance Re, the vibrational wavenumber, #, and the dissociation energy, De: Species Re #/cm−1 De/eV F2 1.411 916.6 1.60 F2 − 1.900 450.0 1.31 Rationalize these data in terms of molecular orbital configurations. 11.11‡ Rydberg molecules are molecules with an electron in an atomic orbital with principal quantum number n one higher than the valence shells of the constituent atoms. Speculate about the existence of ‘hyper Rydberg’ H2 formed from two H atoms with 100s electrons. Make reasonable guesses about the binding energy, the equilibrium internuclear separation, the vibrational force constant, and the rotational constant. Is such a molecule likely to exist under any circumstances? 11.12 In a particular photoelectron spectrum using 21.21 eV photons, electrons were ejected with kinetic energies of 11.01 eV, 8.23 eV, and 5.22 eV. Sketch the molecular orbital energy level diagram for the species, showing the ionization energies of the three identifiable orbitals. V1 − V2 1 − S e2 4πε0R V1 + V2 1 + S e2 4πε0R 11.13‡ Set up and solve the Hückel secular equations for the π electrons of NO3 − . Express the energies in terms of the Coulomb integrals αO and αN and the resonance integral β. Determine the delocalization energy of the ion. 11.14 In the ‘free electron molecular orbital’ (FEMO) theory, the electrons in a conjugated molecule are treated as independent particles in a box of length L. Sketch the form of the two occupied orbitals in butadiene predicted by this model and predict the minimum excitation energy of the molecule. The tetraene CH2=CHCH=CHCH=CHCH=CH2 can be treated as a box of length 8R, where R ≈ 140 pm (as in this case, an extra half bond-length is often added at each end of the box). Calculate the minimum excitation energy of the molecule and sketch the HOMO and LUMO. Estimate the colour a sample of the compound is likely to appear in white light. 11.15 The FEMO theory (Problem 11.14) of conjugated molecules is rather crude and better results are obtained with simple Hückel theory. (a) For a linear conjugated polyene with each of N carbon atoms contributing an electron in a 2p orbital, the energies Ek of the resulting π molecular orbitals are given by (see also Section 20.9): Ek = α + 2βcos k = 1, 2, 3, . . . , N Use this expression to determine a reasonable empirical estimate of the resonance integral β for the homologous series consisting of ethene, butadiene, hexatriene, and octatetraene given that π*←π ultraviolet absorptions from the HOMO to the LUMO occur at 61 500, 46 080, 39 750, and 32 900 cm−1 , respectively. (b) Calculate the π-electron delocalization energy, Edeloc = Eπ −n(α + β), of octatetraene, where Eπ is the total π-electron binding energy and n is the total number of π-electrons. (c) In the context of this Hückel model, the π molecular orbitals are written as linear combinations of the carbon 2p orbitals. The coefficient of the jth atomic orbital in the kth molecular orbital is given by: ckj = 1/2 sin j = 1, 2, 3, . . . , N Determine the values of the coefficients of each of the six 2p orbitals in each of the six π molecular orbitals of hexatriene. Match each set of coefficients (that is, each molecular orbital) with a value of the energy calculated with the expression given in part (a) of the molecular orbital. Comment on trends that relate the energy of a molecular orbital with its ‘shape’, which can be inferred from the magnitudes and signs of the coefficients in the linear combination that describes the molecular orbital. 11.16 For monocyclic conjugated polyenes (such as cyclobutadiene and benzene) with each of N carbon atoms contributing an electron in a 2p orbital, simple Hückel theory gives the following expression for the energies Ek of the resulting π molecular orbitals: Ek = α + 2βcos k = 0, ±1, ±2, . . . , ±N/2 (even N) k = 0, ±1, ±2, . . . , ±(N − 1)/2 (odd N) (a) Calculate the energies of the π molecular orbitals of benzene and cyclooctatetraene. Comment on the presence or absence of degenerate energy levels. (b) Calculate and compare the delocalization energies of benzene (using the expression above) and hexatriene (see Problem 11.15a). What do you conclude from your results? (c) Calculate and compare the delocalization energies of cyclooctaene and octatetraene. Are your conclusions for this pair of molecules the same as for the pair of molecules investigated in part (b)? 11.17 If you have access to mathematical software that can perform matrix diagonalization, use it to solve Problems 11.15 and 11.16, disregarding the expressions for the energies and coefficients given there. 11.18 Molecular orbital calculations based on semi-empirical, ab initio, and DFT methods describe the spectroscopic properties of conjugated molecules a 2kπ N jkπ N + 1 D E F 2 N + 1 A B C kπ N + 1 402 11 MOLECULAR STRUCTURE bit better than simple Hückel theory. (a) Using molecular modelling software2 and the computational method of your choice (semi-empirical, ab initio, or density functioncal methods), calculate the energy separation between the HOMO and LUMO of ethene, butadiene, hexatriene, and octatetraene. (b) Plot the HOMO–LUMO energy separations against the experimental frequencies for π*←π ultraviolet absorptions for these molecules (Problem 11.15). Use mathematical software to find the polynomial equation that best fits the data. (c) Use your polynomial fit from part (b) to estimate the frequency of the π*←π ultraviolet absorption of decapentaene from the calculated HOMO–LUMO energy separation. (d) Discuss why the calibration procedure of part (b) is necessary. 11.19 Electronic excitation of a molecule may weaken or strengthen some bonds because bonding and antibonding characteristics differ between the HOMO and the LUMO. For example, a carbon–carbon bond in a linear polyene may have bonding character in the HOMO and antibonding character in the LUMO. Therefore, promotion of an electron from the HOMO to the LUMO weakens this carbon–carbon bond in the excited electronic state, relative to the ground electronic state. Display the HOMO and LUMO of each molecule in Problem 11.15 and discuss in detail any changes in bond order that accompany the π*←π ultraviolet absorptions in these molecules. 11.20 As mentioned in Section 2.8, molecular electronic structure methods may be used to estimate the standard enthalpy of formation of molecules in the gas phase. (a) Using molecular modelling software and a semi-empirical method of your choice, calculate the standard enthalpy of formation of ethene, butadiene, hexatriene, and octatetraene in the gas phase. (b) Consult a database of thermochemical data, such as the online sources listed in this textbook’s web site, and, for each molecule in part (a), calculate the relative error between the calculated and experimental values of the standard enthalpy of formation. (c) A good thermochemical database will also report the uncertainty in the experimental value of the standard enthalpy of formation. Compare experimental uncertainties with the relative errors calculated in part (b) and discuss the reliability of your chosen semi-empirical method for the estimation of thermochemical properties of linear polyenes. Theoretical problems 11.21 An sp2 hybrid orbital that lies in the xy-plane and makes an angle of 120° to the x-axis has the form ψ = s− px + py Use hydrogenic atomic orbitals to write the explicit form of the hybrid orbital. Show that it has its maximum amplitude in the direction specified. 11.22 Use the expressions in Problems 11.8 and 11.9 to show that the antibonding orbital is more antibonding than the bonding orbital is bonding at most internuclear separations. 11.23 Derive eqns 11.11 and 11.14 by working with the normalized LCAO-MOs for the H2 + molecule-ion (Section 11.3a). Proceed by evaluating the expectation value of the hamiltonian for the ion. Make use of the fact that A and B each individually satisfy the Schrödinger equation for an isolated H atom. 11.24 Take as a trial function for the ground state of the hydrogen atom (a) e−kr , (b) e−kr2 and use the variation principle to find the optimum value of k in each case. Identify the better wavefunction. The only part of the laplacian that need be considered is the part that involves radial derivatives (eqn 9.5). 11.25 We saw in Section 11.5 that, to find the energies of the bonding and antibonding orbitals of a heteronuclear diatomic molecule, we need to solve the secular determinant D E F 31/2 21/2 1 21/2 A B C 1 31/2 2 The web site contains links to molecular modelling freeware and to other sites where you may perform molecular orbital calculations directly from your web browser. = 0 where αA ≠ αB and we have taken S = 0. Equations 11.34a and 11.34b give the general solution to this problem. Here, we shall develop the result for the case (αB − αA)2 >> β2 . (a) Begin by showing that E± = ± 1 + 1/2 where E+ and E− are the energies of the bonding and antibonding molecular orbitals, respectively. (b) Now use the expansion (1 + x)1/2 = 1 + − + · · · to show that E− = αB + E+ = αA − which is the limiting result used in Justification 11.4. Applications: to astrophysics and biology 11.26‡ In Exercise 11.12a you were invited to set up the Hückel secular determinant for linear and cyclic H3. The same secular determinant applies to the molecular ions H3 + and D3 + . The molecular ion H3 + was discovered as long ago as 1912 by J.J. Thomson, but only more recently has the equivalent equilateral triangular structure been confirmed by M.J. Gaillard et al. (Phys. Rev. A17, 1797 (1978)). The molecular ion H3 + is the simplest polyatomic species with a confirmed existence and plays an important role in chemical reactions occurring in interstellar clouds that may lead to the formation of water, carbon monoxide, and ethyl alcohol. The H3 + ion has also been found in the atmospheres of Jupiter, Saturn, and Uranus. (a) Solve the Hückel secular equations for the energies of the H3 system in terms of the parameters α and β, draw an energy level diagram for the orbitals, and determine the binding energies of H3 + , H3, and H3 − . (b) Accurate quantum mechanical calculations by G.D. Carney and R.N. Porter (J. Chem. Phys. 65, 3547 (1976)) give the dissociation energy for the process H3 + → H + H + H+ as 849 kJ mol−1 . From this information and data in Table 11.3, calculate the enthalpy of the reaction H+ (g) + H2(g) → H3 + (g). (c) From your equations and the information given, calculate a value for the resonance integral β in H3 + . Then go on to calculate the bind energies of the other H3 species in (a). 11.27‡ There is some indication that other hydrogen ring compounds and ions in addition to H3 and D3 species may play a role in interstellar chemistry. According to J.S. Wright and G.A. DiLabio (J. Phys. Chem. 96, 10793 (1992)), H5 − , H6, and H7 + are particularly stable whereas H4 and H5 + are not. Confirm these statements by Hückel calculations. 11.28 Here we develop a molecular orbital theory treatment of the peptide group (10), which links amino acids in proteins. Specifically, we shall describe the factors that stabilize the planar conformation of the peptide group. β2 αB − αA β2 αB − αA x3 8 x 2 J K L 4β2 (αA − αB)2 G H I αA − αB 2 αA + αB 2 B αB − E αA − E β PROBLEMS 403 (a) It will be familiar from introductory chemistry that valence bond theory explains the planar conformation of the peptide group by invoking delocalization of the π bond between the oxygen, carbon, and nitrogen atoms (11, 11): It follows that we can model the peptide group with molecular orbital theory by making LCAO-MOs from 2p orbitals perpendicular to the plane defined by the O, C, and N atoms. The three combinations have the form: ψ1 = aψO + bψC + cψN ψ2 = dψO − eψN ψ3 = fψO − gψC + hψN where the coefficients a through h are all positive. Sketch the orbitals ψ1, ψ2, and ψ3 and characterize them as bonding, non-bonding, or antibonding molecular orbitals. In a non-bonding molecular orbital, a pair of electrons resides in an orbital confined largely to one atom and not appreciably involved in bond formation. (b) Show that this treatment is consistent only with a planar conformation of the peptide link. (c) Draw a diagram showing the relative energies of these molecular orbitals and determine the occupancy of the orbitals. Hint. Convince yourself that there are four electrons to be distributed among the molecular orbitals. (d) Now consider a non-planar conformation of the peptide link, in which the O2p and C2p orbitals are perpendicular to the plane defined by the O, C, and N atoms, but the N2p orbital lies on that plane. The LCAO-MOs are given by ψ4 = aψO + bψC ψ5 = eψN ψ6 = fψO − gψC Just as before, sketch these molecular orbitals and characterize them as bonding, non-bonding, or antibonding. Also, draw an energy level diagram and determine the occupancy of the orbitals. (e) Why is this arrangement of atomic orbitals consistent with a non-planar conformation for the peptide link? (f) Does the bonding MO associated with the planar conformation have the same energy as the bonding MO associated with the non-planar conformation? If not, which bonding MO is lower in energy? Repeat the analysis for the non-bonding and anti-bonding molecular orbitals. (g) Use your results from parts (a)–(f) to construct arguments that support the planar model for the peptide link. 11.29 Molecular orbital calculations may be used to predict trends in the standard potentials of conjugated molecules, such as the quinones and flavins, that are involved in biological electron transfer reactions (Impact I17.2). It is commonly assumed that decreasing the energy of the LUMO enhances the ability of a molecule to accept an electron into the LUMO, with an attendant increase in the value of the molecule’s standard potential. Furthermore, a number of studies indicate that there is a linear correlation between the LUMO energy and the reduction potential of aromatic hydrocarbons (see, for example, J.P. Lowe, Quantum chemistry, Chapter 8, Academic Press (1993)). (a) The standard potentials at pH = 7 for the one-electron reduction of methyl-substituted 1,4-benzoquinones (13) to their respective semiquinone radical anions are: R2 R3 R5 R6 E7 /V H H H H 0.078 CH3 H H H 0.023 CH3 H CH3 H −0.067 CH3 CH3 CH3 H −0.165 CH3 CH3 CH3 CH3 −0.260 Using molecular modelling software and the computational method of your choice (semi-empirical, ab initio, or density functional theory methods), calculate ELUMO, the energy of the LUMO of each substituted 1,4-benzoquinone, and plot ELUMO against E7 . Do your calculations support a linear relation between ELUMO and E7 ? (b) The 1,4-benzoquinone for which R2 = R3 = CH3 and R5 = R6 = OCH3 is a suitable model of ubiquinone, a component of the respiratory electron transport chain (Impact I7.2). Determine ELUMO of this quinone and then use your results from part (a) to estimate its standard potential. (c) The 1,4-benzoquinone for which R2 = R3 = R5 = CH3 and R6 = H is a suitable model of plastoquinone, a component of the photosynthetic electron transport chain (Impact I7.2). Determine ELUMO of this quinone and then use your results from part (a) to estimate its standard potential. Is plastoquinone expected to be a better or worse oxidizing agent than ubiquinone? (d) Based on your predictions and on basic concepts of biological electron transport (Impact I7.2 and I23.2), suggest a reason why ubiquinone is used in respiration and plastoquinone is used in photosynthesis. Molecular symmetry In this chapter we sharpen the concept of ‘shape’ into a precise definition of ‘symmetry’, and show that symmetry may be discussed systematically. We see how to classify any molecule according to its symmetry and how to use this classification to discuss molecular properties. After describing the symmetry properties of molecules themselves, we turn to a consideration of the effect of symmetry transformations on orbitals and see that their transformation properties can be used to set up a labelling scheme. These symmetry labels are used to identify integrals that necessarily vanish. One important integral is the overlap integral between two orbitals. By knowing which atomic orbitals may have nonzero overlap, we can decide which ones can contribute to molecular orbitals. We also see how to select linear combinations of atomic orbitals that match the symmetry of the nuclear framework. Finally, by considering the symmetry properties of integrals, we see that it is possible to derive the selection rules that govern spectroscopic transitions. The systematic discussion of symmetry is called group theory. Much of group theory is a summary of common sense about the symmetries of objects. However, because group theory is systematic, its rules can be applied in a straightforward, mechanical way. In most cases the theory gives a simple, direct method for arriving at useful conclusions with the minimum of calculation, and this is the aspect we stress here. In some cases, though, it leads to unexpected results. The symmetry elements of objects Some objects are ‘more symmetrical’ than others. A sphere is more symmetrical than a cube because it looks the same after it has been rotated through any angle about any diameter. A cube looks the same only if it is rotated through certain angles about specific axes, such as 90°, 180°, or 270° about an axis passing through the centres of any of its opposite faces (Fig. 12.1), or by 120° or 240° about an axis passing through any of its opposite corners. Similarly, an NH3 molecule is ‘more symmetrical’ than an H2O molecule because NH3 looks the same after rotations of 120° or 240° about the axis shown in Fig. 12.2, whereas H2O looks the same only after a rotation of 180°. An action that leaves an object looking the same after it has been carried out is called a symmetry operation. Typical symmetry operations include rotations, reflections, and inversions. There is a corresponding symmetryelementfor each symmetry operation, which is the point, line, or plane with respect to which the symmetry operation is performed. For instance, a rotation (a symmetry operation) is carried out around an axis (the corresponding symmetry element). We shall see that we can classify molecules by identifying all their symmetry elements, and grouping together molecules that The symmetry elements of objects 12.1 Operations and symmetry elements 12.2 The symmetry classification of molecules 12.3 Some immediate consequences of symmetry Applications to molecular orbital theory and spectroscopy 12.4 Character tables and symmetry labels 12.5 Vanishing integrals and orbital overlap 12.6 Vanishing integrals and selection rules Checklist of key ideas Further reading Discussion questions Exercises Problems 12 12.1 OPERATIONS AND SYMMETRY ELEMENTS 405 possess the same set of symmetry elements. This procedure, for example, puts the trigonal pyramidal species NH3 and SO3 2− into one group and the angular species H2O and SO2 into another group. 12.1 Operations and symmetry elements The classification of objects according to symmetry elements corresponding to operations that leave at least one common point unchanged gives rise to the point groups. There are five kinds of symmetry operation (and five kinds of symmetry element) of this kind. When we consider crystals (Chapter 20), we shall meet symmetries arising from translation through space. These more extensive groups are called spacegroups. The identity, E, consists of doing nothing; the corresponding symmetry element is the entire object. Because every molecule is indistinguishable from itself if nothing is done to it, every object possesses at least the identity element. One reason for including the identity is that some molecules have only this symmetry element (1); another reason is technical and connected with the detailed formulation of group theory. An n-fold rotation (the operation) about an n-fold axis of symmetry, Cn (the corresponding element) is a rotation through 360°/n. The operation C1 is a rotation through 360°, and is equivalent to the identity operation E. An H2O molecule has one twofold axis, C2. An NH3 molecule has one threefold axis, C3, with which is associated two symmetry operations, one being 120° rotation in a clockwise sense and the other 120° rotation in a counter-clockwise sense. A pentagon has a C5 axis, with two (clockwise and counterclockwise) rotations through 72° associated with it. It also has an axis denoted C5 2 , corresponding to two successive C5 rotations; there are two such operations, one through 144° in a clockwise sense and the other through 144° in a counterclockwise sense. A cube has three C4 axes, four C3 axes, and six C2 axes. However, even this high symmetry is exceeded by a sphere, which possesses an infinite number of symmetry axes (along any diameter) of all possible integral values of n. If a molecule possesses several rotation axes, then the one (or more) with the greatest value of n is called the principal axis. The principal axis of a benzene molecule is the sixfold axis perpendicular to the hexagonal ring (2). C2 C3 C4 Fig. 12.1 Some of the symmetry elements of a cube. The twofold, threefold, and fourfold axes are labelled with the conventional symbols. C2 C3 N H O H (a) (b) Fig. 12.2 (a) An NH3 molecule has a threefold (C3) axis and (b) an H2O molecule has a twofold (C2) axis. Both have other symmetry elements too. F Cl Br I C 1 CBrClFI C6 2 Benzene, C H6 6 Comment 12.1 There is only one twofold rotation associated with a C2 axis because clockwise and counter-clockwise 180° rotations are identical. 406 12 MOLECULAR SYMMETRY A reflection (the operation) in a mirror plane, σ (the element), may contain the principal axis of a molecule or be perpendicular to it. If the plane is parallel to the principal axis, it is called ‘vertical’ and denoted σv. An H2O molecule has two vertical planes of symmetry (Fig. 12.3) and an NH3 molecule has three. A vertical mirror plane that bisects the angle between two C2 axes is called a ‘dihedral plane’ and is denoted σd (Fig. 12.4). When the plane of symmetry is perpendicular to the principal axis it is called ‘horizontal’ and denoted σh. A C6H6 molecule has a C6 principal axis and a horizontal mirror plane (as well as several other symmetry elements). In an inversion (the operation) through a centre of symmetry, i (the element), we imagine taking each point in a molecule, moving it to the centre of the molecule, and then moving it out the same distance on the other side; that is, the point (x, y, z) is taken into the point (−x, −y, −z). Neither an H2O molecule nor an NH3 molecule has a centre of inversion, but a sphere and a cube do have one. A C6H6 molecule does have a centre of inversion, as does a regular octahedron (Fig. 12.5); a regular tetrahedron and a CH4 molecule do not. An n-fold improper rotation (the operation) about an n-fold axis of improper rotation or an n-fold improper rotation axis, Sn, (the symmetry element) is composed of two successive transformations. The first component is a rotation through 360°/n, and the second is a reflection through a plane perpendicular to the axis of that rotation; neither operation alone needs to be a symmetry operation. A CH4 molecule has three S4 axes (Fig. 12.6). 12.2 The symmetry classification of molecules To classify molecules according to their symmetries, we list their symmetry elements and collect together molecules with the same list of elements. This procedure puts CH4 and CCl4, which both possess the same symmetry elements as a regular tetrahedron, into the same group, and H2O into another group. The name of the group to which a molecule belongs is determined by the symmetry elements it possesses. There are two systems of notation (Table 12.1). The Schoenflies system (in which a name looks like C4v) is more common for the discussion of individual molecules, and the Hermann–Mauguin system, or International system (in which a name looks like 4mm), is used almost exclusively in the discussion of crystal symmetry. The identification of a molecule’s point group according to the Schoenflies system is simplified by referring to the flow diagram in Fig. 12.7 and the shapes shown in Fig. 12.8. v v´ s s d d ds s s Fig. 12.3 An H2O molecule has two mirror planes. They are both vertical (i.e. contain the principal axis), so are denoted σv and σv′. Fig. 12.4 Dihedral mirror planes (σd) bisect the C2 axes perpendicular to the principal axis. Centre of inversion,i Fig. 12.5 A regular octahedron has a centre of inversion (i). h h C4 S4 C6 S6 (a) (b) s s Fig. 12.6 (a) A CH4 molecule has a fourfold improper rotation axis (S4): the molecule is indistinguishable after a 90° rotation followed by a reflection across the horizontal plane, but neither operation alone is a symmetry operation. (b) The staggered form of ethane has an S6 axis composed of a 60° rotation followed by a reflection. 12.2 THE SYMMETRY CLASSIFICATION OF MOLECULES 407 Cnv S2n Molecule Linear?Y N i?Y N Y N Two or more , > 2?C nn Y N i? C5? Y NIh Td YY Y N ?Cs N h? Y N n d?Dnd Dn Y N h? Y N N Cnh Y n v? S2n? Y N Cn N Y N i?Ci Select with highest ; then, are the perpendicular to ? C n nC C n n 2 Dnh Cn? D¥h C¥v Oh C1 s s s s s Fig. 12.7 A flow diagram for determining the point group of a molecule. Start at the top and answer the question posed in each diamond (Y = yes, N = no). (a) The groups C1, Ci, and Cs A molecule belongs to the group C1 if it has no element other than the identity, as in (1). It belongs to Ci if it has the identity and the inversion alone (3), and to Cs if it has the identity and a mirror plane alone (4). COOH OH H COOH H OH Centre of inversion 3 Meso-tartaric acid, HOOCCH(OH)CH(OH)COOH N 4 Quinoline, C H N9 7 408 12 MOLECULAR SYMMETRY Cone 2 3 4 5 6 ¥ Cn Dn Cnv Dnh Dnd Cnh S2n (plane or bipyramid) (pyramid) n = Fig. 12.8 A summary of the shapes corresponding to different point groups. The group to which a molecule belongs can often be identified from this diagram without going through the formal procedure in Fig. 12.7. Table 12.1 The notation for point groups* Ci ⁄ Cs m C1 1 C2 2 C3 3 C4 4 C6 6 C2v 2mm C3v 3m C4v 4mm C6v 6mm C2h 2m C3h fl C4h 4/m C6h 6/m D2 222 D3 32 D4 422 D6 622 D2h mmm D3h fl2m D4h 4/mmm D6h 6/mmm D2d ›2m D3d ‹m S4 ›/m S6 3 – T 23 Td ›3m Th m3 O 432 Oh m3m * In the International system (or Hermann–Mauguin system) for point groups, a number n denotes the presence of an n-fold axis and m denotes a mirror plane. A slash (/) indicates that the mirror plane is perpendicular to the symmetry axis. It is important to distinguish symmetry elements of the same type but of different classes, as in 4/mmm, in which there are three classes of mirror plane. A bar over a number indicates that the element is combined with an inversion. The only groups listed here are the so-called ‘crystallographic point groups’ (Section 20.1). 12.2 THE SYMMETRY CLASSIFICATION OF MOLECULES 409 (b) The groups Cn, Cnv, and Cnh A molecule belongs to the group Cn if it possesses an n-fold axis. Note that symbol Cn is now playing a triple role: as the label of a symmetry element, a symmetry operation, and a group. For example, an H2O2 molecule has the elements E and C2 (5), so it belongs to the group C2. If in addition to the identity and a Cn axis a molecule has n vertical mirror planes σv, then it belongs to the group Cnv. An H2O molecule, for example, has the symmetry elements E, C2, and 2σv, so it belongs to the group C2v. An NH3 molecule has the elements E, C3, and 3σv, so it belongs to the group C3v. A heteronuclear diatomic molecule such as HCl belongs to the group C∞v because all rotations around the axis and reflections across the axis are symmetry operations. Other members of the group C∞v include the linear OCS molecule and a cone. Objects that in addition to the identity and an n-fold principal axis also have a horizontal mirror plane σh belong to the groups Cnh. An example is trans-CHCl=CHCl (6), which has the elements E, C2, and σh, so belongs to the group C2h; the molecule B(OH)3 in the conformation shown in (7) belongs to the group C3h. The presence of certain symmetry elements may be implied by the presence of others: thus, in C2h the operations C2 and σh jointly imply the presence of a centre of inversion (Fig. 12.9). (c) The groups Dn, Dnh, and Dnd We see from Fig. 12.7 that a molecule that has an n-fold principal axis and n twofold axes perpendicular to Cn belongs to the group Dn. A molecule belongs to Dnh if it also possesses a horizontal mirror plane. The planar trigonal BF3 molecule has the elements E, C3, 3C2, and σh (with one C2 axis along each B-F bond), so belongs to D3h (8). The C6H6 molecule has the elements E, C6, 3C2, 3C2′, and σh together with some others that these elements imply, so it belongs to D6h. All homonuclear diatomic molecules, such as N2, belong to the group D∞h because all rotations around the axis are symmetry operations, as are end-to-end rotation and end-to-end reflection; D∞h is also the group of the linear OCO and HCCH molecules and of a uniform cylinder. Other examples of Dnh molecules are shown in (9), (10), and (11). A molecule belongs to the group Dnd if in addition to the elements of Dn it possesses n dihedral mirror planes σd. The twisted, 90° allene (12) belongs to D2d, and the staggered conformation of ethane (13) belongs to D3d. (d) The groups Sn Molecules that have not been classified into one of the groups mentioned so far, but that possess one Sn axis, belong to the group Sn. An example is tetraphenylmethane, which belongs to the point group S4 (14). Molecules belonging to Sn with n > 4 are rare. Note that the group S2 is the same as Ci, so such a molecule will already have been classified as Ci. O H C2 5 Hydrogen peroxide, H O2 2 h C2 i s Fig. 12.9 The presence of a twofold axis and a horizontal mirror plane jointly imply the presence of a centre of inversion in the molecule. Cl Cl C2 6 CHCl=CHCltrans- hs B OH 7 B(OH)3 C3 hs B F 8 Boron trifluoride, BF3 Comment 12.2 The prime on 3C2′ indicates that the three C2 axes are different from the other three C2 axes. In benzene, three of the C2 axes bisect C-C bonds and the other three pass through vertices of the hexagon formed by the carbon framework of the molecule. 410 12 MOLECULAR SYMMETRY (e) The cubic groups A number of very important molecules (e.g. CH4 and SF6) possess more than one principal axis. Most belong to the cubic groups, and in particular to the tetrahedral groups T, Td, and Th (Fig. 12.10a) or to the octahedralgroups O and Oh (Fig. 12.10b). A few icosahedral (20-faced) molecules belonging to the icosahedral group, I (Fig. 12.10c), are also known: they include some of the boranes and buckminsterfullerene, C60 (15). The groups Td and Oh are the groups of the regular tetrahedron (for instance, CH4) and the regular octahedron (for instance, SF6), respectively. If the object possesses the rotational symmetry of the tetrahedron or the octahedron, but none of their planes of reflection, then it belongs to the simpler groups T or O (Fig.12.11).ThegroupTh isbasedonTbutalsocontainsacentreofinversion(Fig.12.12). P Cl C3 C2 C2 C2 h 10 Phosphorus pentachloride, PCl ( )5 3hD s h C4 C2 C2 C2 – Cl Au 11 Tetrachloroaurate(III) ion, [AuCl ] ( )4 4h - D s h C2 C2 9 Ethene, CH =CH ( )2 2 2hD s C2 C2 C S2 4, 12 Allene, C H ( )3 4 2dD d C2 C S3 3, 13 Ethane, C H ( )2 6 3dD s S4 Ph 14 Tetraphenylmethane, C(C H ) ( )6 5 4 4S (a) (b) (c) 15 Buckminsterfullerene, C ( )60 I Fig. 12.10 (a) Tetrahedral, (b) octahedral, and (c) icosahedral molecules are drawn in a way that shows their relation to a cube: they belong to the cubicgroups Td, Oh, and Ih, respectively. 12.3 SOME IMMEDIATE CONSEQUENCES OF SYMMETRY 411 (a) T (b) O Fig. 12.11 Shapes corresponding to the point groups (a) T and (b) O. The presence of the decorated slabs reduces the symmetry of the object from Td and Oh, respectively. Fig. 12.12 The shape of an object belonging to the group Th. cp (= C H )5 5 Ru 16 Ruthenocene, Ru(cp)2 Comment 12.3 The web site contains links to interactive tutorials, where you use your web browser to to assign point groups of molecules. cp (= C H )5 5 Fe 17 Ferrocene, Fe(cp)2 (f) The full rotation group The full rotation group, R3 (the 3 refers to rotation in three dimensions), consists of an infinite number of rotation axes with all possible values of n. A sphere and an atom belong to R3, but no molecule does. Exploring the consequences of R3 is a very important way of applying symmetry arguments to atoms, and is an alternative approach to the theory of orbital angular momentum. Example 12.1 Identifying a point group of a molecule Identify the point group to which a ruthenocene molecule (16) belongs. Method Use the flow diagram in Fig. 12.7. Answer The path to trace through the flow diagram in Fig. 12.7 is shown by a green line; it ends at Dnh. Because the molecule has a fivefold axis, it belongs to the group D5h. If the rings were staggered, as they are in an excited state of ferrocene that lies 4 kJ mol−1 above the ground state (17), the horizontal reflection plane would be absent, but dihedral planes would be present. Self-test 12.1 Classify the pentagonal antiprismatic excited state of ferrocene (17). [D5d] 12.3 Some immediate consequences of symmetry Some statements about the properties of a molecule can be made as soon as its point group has been identified. (a) Polarity A polar molecule is one with a permanent electric dipole moment (HCl, O3, and NH3 are examples). If the molecule belongs to the group Cn with n > 1, it cannot possess a charge distribution with a dipole moment perpendicular to the symmetry axis because the symmetry of the molecule implies that any dipole that exists in one direction perpendicular to the axis is cancelled by an opposing dipole (Fig. 12.13a). For example, the perpendicular component of the dipole associated with one O-H bond in H2O is cancelled by an equal but opposite component of the dipole of the second O-H bond, so any dipole that the molecule has must be parallel to the twofold symmetry axis. 412 12 MOLECULAR SYMMETRY However, as the group makes no reference to operations relating the two ends of the molecule, a charge distribution may exist that results in a dipole along the axis (Fig. 12.13b), and H2O has a dipole moment parallel to its twofold symmetry axis. The same remarks apply generally to the group Cnv, so molecules belonging to any of the Cnv groups may be polar. In all the other groups, such as C3h, D, etc., there are symmetry operations that take one end of the molecule into the other. Therefore, as well as having no dipole perpendicular to the axis, such molecules can have none along the axis, for otherwise these additional operations would not be symmetry operations. We can conclude that only molecules belonging to the groups Cn, Cnv, and Cs may have a permanent electric dipole moment. For Cn and Cnv, that dipole moment must lie along the symmetry axis. Thus ozone, O3, which is angular and belongs to the group C2v, may be polar (and is), but carbon dioxide, CO2, which is linear and belongs to the group D∞h, is not. (b) Chirality A chiral molecule (from the Greek word for ‘hand’) is a molecule that cannot be superimposed on its mirror image. An achiral molecule is a molecule that can be superimposed on its mirror image. Chiral molecules are optically active in the sense that they rotate the plane of polarized light (a property discussed in more detail in Appendix 3). A chiral molecule and its mirror-image partner constitute an enantiomeric pair of isomers and rotate the plane of polarization in equal but opposite directions. A molecule may be chiral, and therefore optically active, only if it does not possess an axis of improper rotation, Sn. However, we need to be aware that such an axis may be present under a different name, and be implied by other symmetry elements that are present. For example, molecules belonging to the groups Cnh possess an Sn axis implicitly because they possess both Cn and σh, which are the two components of an improper rotation axis. Any molecule containing a centre of inversion, i, also possesses an S2 axis, because i is equivalent to C2 in conjunction with σh, and that combination of elements is S2 (Fig. 12.14). It follows that all molecules with centres of inversion are achiral and hence optically inactive. Similarly, because S1 = σ, it follows that any molecule with a mirror plane is achiral. A molecule may be chiral if it does not have a centre of inversion or a mirror plane, which is the case with the amino acid alanine (18), but not with glycine (19). However, a molecule may be achiral even though it does not have a centre of inversion. For example, the S4 species (20) is achiral and optically inactive: though it lacks i (that is, S2) it does have an S4 axis. (a) (b) Fig. 12.13 (a) A molecule with a Cn axis cannot have a dipole perpendicular to the axis, but (b) it may have one parallel to the axis. The arrows represent local contributions to the overall electric dipole, such as may arise from bonds between pairs of neighbouring atoms with different electronegativities. i S2 Fig. 12.14 Some symmetry elements are implied by the other symmetry elements in a group. Any molecule containing an inversion also possesses at least an S2 element because i and S2 are equivalent. COOH C NH2 CH3 H 18 -Alanine, NH CH(CH )COOHL 2 3 NH2 C COOH H H 19 Glycine, NH CH COOH2 2 H N HH3C H H CH3 CH3 H3C S4 20 N(CH CH(CH )CH(CH )CH )2 3 3 2 2 + + 12.4 CHARACTER TABLES AND SYMMETRY LABELS 413 Applications to molecular orbital theory and spectroscopy We shall now turn our attention away from the symmetries of molecules themselves and direct it towards the symmetry characteristics of orbitals that belong to the various atoms in a molecule. This material will enable us to discuss the formulation and labelling of molecular orbitals and selection rules in spectroscopy. 12.4 Character tables and symmetry labels We saw in Chapter 11 that molecular orbitals of diatomic and linear polyatomic molecules are labelled σ, π, etc. These labels refer to the symmetries of the orbitals with respect to rotations around the principal symmetry axis of the molecule. Thus, a σ orbital does not change sign under a rotation through any angle, a π orbital changes sign when rotated by 180°, and so on (Fig. 12.15). The symmetry classifications σ and π can also be assigned to individual atomic orbitals in a linear molecule. For example, we can speak of an individual pz orbital as having σ symmetry if the z-axis lies along the bond, because pz is cylindrically symmetrical about the bond. This labelling of orbitals according to their behaviour under rotations can be generalized and extended to nonlinear polyatomic molecules, where there may be reflections and inversions to take into account as well as rotations. (a) Representations and characters Labels analogous to σ and π are used to denote the symmetries of orbitals in polyatomic molecules. These labels look like a, a1, e, eg, and we first encountered them in Fig. 11.4 in connection with the molecular orbitals of benzene. As we shall see, these labels indicate the behaviour of the orbitals under the symmetry operations of the relevant point group of the molecule. A label is assigned to an orbital by referring to the character table of the group, a table that characterizes the different symmetry types possible in the point group. Thus, to assign the labels σ and π, we use the table shown in the margin. This table is a fragment of the full character table for a linear molecule. The entry +1 shows that the orbital remains the same and the entry −1 shows that the orbital changes sign under the operation C2 at the head of the column (as illustrated in Fig. 12.15). So, to assign the label σ or π to a particular orbital, we compare the orbital’s behaviour with the information in the character table. The entries in a complete character table are derived by using the formal techniques of group theory and are called characters, χ (chi). These numbers characterize the essential features of each symmetry type in a way that we can illustrate by considering the C2v molecule SO2 and the valence px orbitals on each atom, which we shall denote pS, pA, and pB (Fig. 12.16). Under σv, the change (pS, pB, pA) ← (pS, pA, pB) takes place. We can express this transformation by using matrix multiplication: (pS, pB, pA) = (pS, pA, pB) = (pS, pA, pB)D(σv) (12.1) The matrix D(σv) is called a representative of the operation σv. Representatives take different forms according to the basis, the set of orbitals, that has been adopted. 1 0 0 0 0 1 0 1 0 ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ ⎟ s p + + Fig. 12.15 A rotation through 180° about the internuclear axis (perpendicular to the page) leaves the sign of a σ orbital unchanged but the sign of a π orbital is changed. In the language introduced in this chapter, the characters of the C2 rotation are +1 and −1 for the σ and π orbitals, respectively. C2 (i.e. rotation by 180°) σ +1 (i.e. no change of sign) π −1 (i.e. change of sign) Comment 12.4 See Appendix 2 for a summary of the rules of matrix algebra. - - - B + S + A + Fig. 12.16 The three px orbitals that are used to illustrate the construction of a matrix representation in a C2v molecule (SO2). 414 12 MOLECULAR SYMMETRY We can use the same technique to find matrices that reproduce the other symmetry operations. For instance, C2 has the effect (−pS, −pB, −pA) ← (pS, pA, pB), and its representative is D(C2) = (12.2) The effect of σ′v is (−pS, −pA, −pB) ← (pS, pA, pB), and its representative is D(σ′v) = (12.3) The identity operation has no effect on the basis, so its representative is the 3 × 3 unit matrix: D(E) = (12.4) The set of matrices that represents all the operations of the group is called a matrix representation, Γ (uppercase gamma), of the group for the particular basis we have chosen. We denote this three-dimensional representation by Γ(3) . The discovery of a matrix representation of the group means that we have found a link between symbolic manipulations of operations and algebraic manipulations of numbers. The character of an operation in a particular matrix representation is the sum of the diagonal elements of the representative of that operation. Thus, in the basis we are illustrating, the characters of the representatives are D(E) D(C2) D(σv) D(σ′v) 3 −1 1 −3 The character of an operation depends on the basis. Inspection of the representatives shows that they are all of block-diagonal form: D = The block-diagonal form of the representatives show us that the symmetry operations of C2v never mix pS with the other two functions. Consequently, the basis can be cut into two parts, one consisting of pS alone and the other of (pA, pB). It is readily verified that the pS orbital itself is a basis for the one-dimensional representation D(E) = 1 D(C2) = −1 D(σv) = 1 D(σ′v) = −1 which we shall call Γ(1) . The remaining two basis functions are a basis for the twodimensional representation Γ(2) : D(E) = D(C2) = D(σv) = D(σv′) = These matrices are the same as those of the original three-dimensional representation, except for the loss of the first row and column. We say that the original threedimensional representation has been reduced to the ‘direct sum’ of a one-dimensional representation ‘spanned’ by pS, and a two-dimensional representation spanned by (pA, pB). This reduction is consistent with the common sense view that the central − − ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ 1 0 0 1 0 1 1 0 ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ 0 1 1 0 − − ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ 1 0 0 1 ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ [ ] [ ] [ ] [ ] [ ] n n n n n 0 0 0 0 ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ ⎟ 1 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 1 ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ ⎟ − − − ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ ⎟ 1 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 1 − − − ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ ⎟ 1 0 0 0 0 1 0 1 0 12.4 CHARACTER TABLES AND SYMMETRY LABELS 415 orbital plays a role different from the other two. We denote the reduction symbolically by writing Γ(3) = Γ(1) + Γ(2) (12.5) The one-dimensional representation Γ (1) cannot be reduced any further, and is called an irreducible representation of the group (an ‘irrep’). We can demonstrate that the two-dimensional representation Γ(2) is reducible (for this basis in this group) by switching attention to the linear combinations p1 = pA + pB and p2 = pA − pB. These combinations are sketched in Fig. 12.17. The representatives in the new basis can be constructed from the old by noting, for example, that under σv, (pB, pA) ← (pA, pB). In this way we find the following representation in the new basis: D(E) = D(C2) = D(σv) = D(σv′) = The new representatives are all in block-diagonal form, and the two combinations are not mixed with each other by any operation of the group. We have therefore achieved the reduction of Γ(2) to the sum of two one-dimensional representations. Thus, p1 spans D(E) = 1 D(C2) = −1 D(σv) = 1 D(σv′) = −1 which is the same one-dimensional representation as that spanned by pS, and p2 spans D(E) = 1 D(C2) = 1 D(σv) = −1 D(σv′) = −1 which is a different one-dimensional representation; we shall denote it Γ(1) ′. At this point we have found two irreducible representations of the group C2v (Table 12.2). The two irreducible representations are normally labelled B1 and A2, respectively. An A or a B is used to denote a one-dimensional representation; A is used if the character under the principal rotation is +1, and B is used if the character is −1. Subscripts are used to distinguish the irreducible representations if there is more than one of the same type: A1 is reserved for the representation with character 1 for all operations. When higher dimensional irreducible representations are permitted, E denotes a two-dimensional irreducible representation and T a three-dimensional irreduciblerepresentation;alltheirreduciblerepresentationsofC2v areone-dimensional. There are in fact only two more species of irreducible representations of this group, for a surprising theorem of group theory states that Number of symmetry species = number of classes (12.6) Symmetry operations fall into the same class if they are of the same type (for example, rotations) and can be transformed into one another by a symmetry operation of the − − ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1− ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ −⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ + - - - A + B + A + B Fig. 12.17 Two symmetry-adapted linear combinations of the basis orbitals shown in Fig. 12.16. The two combinations each span a one-dimensional irreducible representation, and their symmetry species are different. Table 12.2* The C2v character table C2v, 2mm E C2 σv σ′v h = 4 A1 1 1 1 1 z z2 , y2 , x2 A2 1 1 −1 −1 xy B1 1 −1 1 −1 x zx B2 1 −1 −1 1 y yz * More character tables are given at the end of the Data section. 416 12 MOLECULAR SYMMETRY group. In C2v, for instance, there are four classes (four columns in the character table), so there are only four species of irreducible representation. The character table in Table 12.2 therefore shows the characters of all the irreducible representations of this group. (b) The structure of character tables In general, the columns in a character table are labelled with the symmetry operations of the group. For instance, for the group C3v the columns are headed E, C3, and σv (Table 12.3). The numbers multiplying each operation are the numbers of members of each class. In the C3v character table we see that the two threefold rotations (clockwise and counter-clockwise rotations by 120°) belong to the same class: they are related by a reflection (Fig. 12.18). The three reflections (one through each of the three vertical mirror planes) also lie in the same class: they are related by the threefold rotations. The two reflections of the group C2v fall into different classes: although they are both reflections, one cannot be transformed into the other by any symmetry operation of the group. The total number of operations in a group is called the order, h, of the group. The order of the group C3v, for instance, is 6. The rows under the labels for the operations summarize the symmetry properties of the orbitals. They are labelled with the symmetry species (the analogues of the labels σ and π). More formally, the symmetry species label the irreducible representations of the group, which are the basic types of behaviour that orbitals may show when subjected to the symmetry operations of the group, as we have illustrated for the group C2v. By convention, irreducible representations are labelled with upper case Roman letters (such as A1 and E) but the orbitals to which they apply are labelled with the lower case italic equivalents (so an orbital of symmetry species A1 is called an a1 orbital). Examples of each type of orbital are shown in Fig. 12.19. (c) Character tables and orbital degeneracy The character of the identity operation E tells us the degeneracy of the orbitals. Thus, in a C3v molecule, any orbital with a symmetry label a1 or a2 is nondegenerate. Any doubly degenerate pair of orbitals in C3v must be labelled e because, in this group, only E symmetry species have characters greater than 1. Because there are no characters greater than 2 in the column headed E in C3v, we know that there can be no triply degenerate orbitals in a C3v molecule. This last point is a powerful result of group theory, for it means that, with a glance at the character table of a molecule, we can state the maximum possible degeneracy of its orbitals. Table 12.3* The C3v character table C3v, 3m E 2C3 3σv h = 6 A1 1 1 1 z z2 , x2 + y2 A2 1 1 −1 E 2 −1 0 (x, y) (xy, x2 − y2 ), (yz, zx) * More character tables are given at the end of the Data section. C3 C3 v v¢v² s s s + Fig. 12.18 Symmetry operations in the same class are related to one another by the symmetry operations of the group. Thus, the three mirror frames shown here are related by threefold rotations, and the two rotations shown here are related by reflection in σv. Comment 12.5 Note that care must be taken to distinguish the identity element E (italic, a column heading) from the symmetry label E (roman, a row label). 12.4 CHARACTER TABLES AND SYMMETRY LABELS 417 a1 a2 e e sN Fig. 12.19 Typical symmetry-adapted linear combinations of orbitals in a C3v molecule. + - + - -1-1 +1 Fig. 12.20 The two orbitals shown here have different properties under reflection through the mirror plane: one changes sign (character −1), the other does not (character +1). Example 12.2 Using a character table to judge degeneracy Can a trigonal planar molecule such as BF3 have triply degenerate orbitals? What is the minimum number of atoms from which a molecule can be built that does display triple degeneracy? Method First, identify the point group, and then refer to the corresponding character table in the Data section. The maximum number in the column headed by the identity E is the maximum orbital degeneracy possible in a molecule of that point group. For the second part, consider the shapes that can be built from two, three, etc. atoms, and decide which number can be used to form a molecule that can have orbitals of symmetry species T. Answer Trigonal planar molecules belong to the point group D3h. Reference to the character table for this group shows that the maximum degeneracy is 2, as no character exceeds 2 in the column headed E. Therefore, the orbitals cannot be triply degenerate. A tetrahedral molecule (symmetry group T) has an irreducible representation with a T symmetry species. The minimum number of atoms needed to build such a molecule is four (as in P4, for instance). Self-test 12.2 A buckminsterfullerene molecule, C60 (15), belongs to the icosahedral point group. What is the maximum possible degree of degeneracy of its orbitals? [5] (d) Characters and operations The characters in the rows labelled A and B and in the columns headed by symmetry operations other than the identity E indicate the behaviour of an orbital under the corresponding operations: a +1 indicates that an orbital is unchanged, and a −1 indicates that it changes sign. It follows that we can identify the symmetry label of the orbital by comparing the changes that occur to an orbital under each operation, and then comparing the resulting +1 or −1 with the entries in a row of the character table for the point group concerned. For the rows labelled E or T (which refer to the behaviour of sets of doubly and triply degenerate orbitals, respectively), the characters in a row of the table are the sums of the characters summarizing the behaviour of the individual orbitals in the basis. Thus, if one member of a doubly degenerate pair remains unchanged under a symmetry operation but the other changes sign (Fig. 12.20), then the entry is reported as χ = 1 − 1 = 0. Care must be exercised with these characters because the transformations of orbitals can be quite complicated; nevertheless, the sums of the individual characters are integers. As an example, consider the O2px orbital in H2O. Because H2O belongs to the point group C2v, we know by referring to the C2v character table (Table 12.2) that the labels available for the orbitals are a1, a2, b1, and b2. We can decide the appropriate label for O2px by noting that under a 180° rotation (C2) the orbital changes sign (Fig. 12.21), so it must be either B1 or B2, as only these two symmetry types have character −1 under C2. The O2px orbital also changes sign under the reflection σv′, which identifies it as B1. As we shall see, any molecular orbital built from this atomic orbital will also be a b1 orbital. Similarly, O2py changes sign under C2 but not under σv′; therefore, it can contribute to b2 orbitals. The behaviour of s, p, and d orbitals on a central atom under the symmetry operations of the molecule is so important that the symmetry species of these orbitals 418 12 MOLECULAR SYMMETRY v v´ C2 + - s s Fig. 12.21 A px orbital on the central atom of a C2v molecule and the symmetry elements of the group. sA sB sC Fig. 12.22 The three H1s orbitals used to construct symmetry-adapted linear combinations in a C3v molecule such as NH3. N + - O + O Fig. 12.23 One symmetry-adapted linear combination of O2px orbitals in the C2v NO2 − ion. A B CD 21 are generally indicated in a character table. To make these allocations, we look at the symmetry species of x, y, and z, which appear on the right-hand side of the character table. Thus, the position of z in Table 12.3 shows that pz (which is proportional to zf(r)), has symmetry species A1 in C3v, whereas px and py (which are proportional to xf(r) and yf(r), respectively) are jointly of E symmetry. In technical terms, we say that px and py jointly span an irreducible representation of symmetry species E. An s orbital on the central atom always spans the fully symmetrical irreducible representation (typically labelled A1 but sometimes A1′) of a group as it is unchanged under all symmetry operations. The five d orbitals of a shell are represented by xy for dxy, etc, and are also listed on the right of the character table. We can see at a glance that in C3v, dxy and dx2 − y2 on a central atom jointly belong to E and hence form a doubly degenerate pair. (e) The classification of linear combinations of orbitals So far, we have dealt with the symmetry classification of individual orbitals. The same technique may be applied to linear combinations of orbitals on atoms that are related by symmetry transformations of the molecule, such as the combination ψ1 = ψA + ψB + ψC of the three H1s orbitals in the C3v molecule NH3 (Fig. 12.22). This combination remains unchanged under a C3 rotation and under any of the three vertical reflections of the group, so its characters are χ(E) = 1 χ(C3) = 1 χ(σv) = 1 Comparison with the C3v character table shows that ψ1 is of symmetry species A1, and therefore that it contributes to a1 molecular orbitals in NH3. Example 12.3 Identifying the symmetry species of orbitals Identify the symmetry species of the orbital ψ = ψA − ψB in a C2v NO2 molecule, where ψA is an O2px orbital on one O atom and ψB that on the other O atom. Method The negative sign in ψ indicates that the sign of ψB is opposite to that of ψA. We need to consider how the combination changes under each operation of the group, and then write the character as +1, −1, or 0 as specified above. Then we compare the resulting characters with each row in the character table for the point group, and hence identify the symmetry species. Answer The combination is shown in Fig. 12.23. Under C2, ψ changes into itself, implying a character of +1. Under the reflection σv, both orbitals change sign, so ψ → −ψ , implying a character of −1. Under σv′, ψ → −ψ, so the character for this operation is also −1. The characters are therefore χ(E) = 1 χ(C2) = 1 χ(σv) = −1 χ(σv′) = −1 These values match the characters of the A2 symmetry species, so ψ can contribute to an a2 orbital. Self-test 12.3 Consider PtCl4 − , in which the Cl ligands form a square planar array of point group D4h (21). Identify the symmetry type of the combination ψA − ψB + ψC − ψD. [B2g] 12.5 VANISHING INTEGRALS AND ORBITAL OVERLAP 419 12.5 Vanishing integrals and orbital overlap Suppose we had to evaluate the integral I = Ύf1f2 dτ (12.7) where f1 and f2 are functions. For example, f1 might be an atomic orbital A on one atom and f2 an atomic orbital B on another atom, in which case I would be their overlap integral. If we knew that the integral is zero, we could say at once that a molecular orbital does not result from (A,B) overlap in that molecule. We shall now see that character tables provide a quick way of judging whether an integral is necessarily zero. (a) The criteria for vanishing integrals The key point in dealing with the integral I is that the value of any integral, and of an overlap integral in particular, is independent of the orientation of the molecule (Fig. 12.24). In group theory we express this point by saying that I is invariant under any symmetry operation of the molecule, and that each operation brings about the trivial transformation I → I. Because the volume element dτ is invariant under any symmetry operation, it follows that the integral is nonzero only if the integrand itself, the product f1f2, is unchanged by any symmetry operation of the molecular point group. If the integrand changed sign under a symmetry operation, the integral would be the sum of equal and opposite contributions, and hence would be zero. It follows that the only contribution to a nonzero integral comes from functions for which under any symmetry operation of the molecular point group f1f2 → f1f2, and hence for which the characters of the operations are all equal to +1. Therefore, for I not to be zero, the integrand f1f2 must have symmetry species A1 (or its equivalent in the specific molecular point group). We use the following procedure to deduce the symmetry species spanned by the product f1f2 and hence to see whether it does indeed span A1. 1 Decide on the symmetry species of the individual functions f1 and f2 by reference to the character table, and write their characters in two rows in the same order as in the table. 2 Multiply the numbers in each column, writing the results in the same order. 3 Inspect the row so produced, and see if it can be expressed as a sum of characters fromeachcolumnofthegroup.TheintegralmustbezeroifthissumdoesnotcontainA1. For example, if f1 is the sN orbital in NH3 and f2 is the linear combination s3 = sB − sC (Fig. 12.25), then, because sN spans A1 and s3 is a member of the basis spanning E, we write f1: 1 1 1 f2: 2 −1 0 f1f2: 2 −1 0 The characters 2, −1, 0 are those of E alone, so the integrand does not span A1. It follows that the integral must be zero. Inspection of the form of the functions (see Fig. 12.25) shows why this is so: s3 has a node running through sN. Had we taken f1 = sN and f2 = s1 instead, where s1 = sA + sB + sC, then because each spans A1 with characters 1,1,1: f1: 1 1 1 f2: 1 1 1 f1f2: 1 1 1 x y y x (a) (b) Fig. 12.24 The value of an integral I (for example, an area) is independent of the coordinate system used to evaluate it. That is, I is a basis of a representation of symmetry species A1 (or its equivalent). sBsC +Fig. 12.25 A symmetry-adapted linear combination that belongs to the symmetry species E in a C3v molecule such as NH3. This combination can form a molecular orbital by overlapping with the px orbital on the central atom (the orbital with its axis parallel to the width of the page; see Fig. 12.28c). 420 12 MOLECULAR SYMMETRY x y + + - Fig. 12.26 The integral of the function f = xy over the tinted region is zero. In this case, the result is obvious by inspection, but group theory can be used to establish similar results in less obvious cases. The insert shows the shape of the function in three dimensions. x y + Fig. 12.27 The integration of a function over a pentagonal region. The insert shows the shape of the function in three dimensions. The characters of the product are those of A1 itself. Therefore, s1 and sN may have nonzero overlap. A shortcut that works when f1 and f2 are bases for irreducible representations of a group is to note their symmetry species: if they are different, then the integral of their product must vanish; if they are the same, then the integral may be nonzero. It is important to note that group theory is specific about when an integral must be zero, but integrals that it allows to be nonzero may be zero for reasons unrelated to symmetry. For example, the N-H distance in ammonia may be so great that the (s1, sN) overlap integral is zero simply because the orbitals are so far apart. Example 12.4 Deciding if an integral must be zero (1) May the integral of the function f = xy be nonzero when evaluated over a region the shape of an equilateral triangle centred on the origin (Fig. 12.26)? Method First, note that an integral over a single function f is included in the previous discussion if we take f1 = f and f2 = 1 in eqn 12.7. Therefore, we need to judge whether f alone belongs to the symmetry species A1 (or its equivalent) in the point group of the system. To decide that, we identify the point group and then examine the character table to see whether f belongs to A1 (or its equivalent). Answer An equilateral triangle has the point-group symmetry D3h. If we refer to the character table of the group, we see that xy is a member of a basis that spans the irreducible representation E′. Therefore, its integral must be zero, because the integrand has no component that spans A1′. Self-test 12.4 Can the function x2 + y2 have a nonzero integral when integrated over a regular pentagon centred on the origin? [Yes, Fig. 12.27] In many cases, the product of functions f1 and f2 spans a sum of irreducible representations. For instance, in C2v we may find the characters 2, 0, 0, −2 when we multiply the characters of f1 and f2 together. In this case, we note that these characters are the sum of the characters for A2 and B1: E C2v σv σ′v A2 1 1 −1 −1 B1 1 −1 1 −1 A2 + B1 2 0 0 −2 To summarize this result we write the symbolic expression A2 × B1 = A2 + B1, which is called the decomposition of a direct product. This expression is symbolic. The × and + signs in this expression are not ordinary multiplication and addition signs: formally, they denote technical procedures with matrices called a ‘direct product’ and a ‘direct sum’. Because the sum on the right does not include a component that is a basis for an irreducible representation of symmetry species A1, we can conclude that the integral of f1f2 over all space is zero in a C2v molecule. Whereas the decomposition of the characters 2, 0, 0, −2 can be done by inspection in this simple case, in other cases and more complex groups the decomposition is often far from obvious. For example, if we found the characters 8, −2, −6, 4, it would not be obvious that the sum contains A1. Group theory, however, provides a systematic way of using the characters of the representation spanned by a product to find the symmetry species of the irreducible representations. The recipe is as follows: 12.5 VANISHING INTEGRALS AND ORBITAL OVERLAP 421 (a) (b) (c) Fig. 12.28 Orbitals of the same symmetry species may have non-vanishing overlap. This diagram illustrates the three bonding orbitals that may be constructed from (N2s, H1s) and (N2p, H1s) overlap in a C3v molecule. (a) a1; (b) and (c) the two components of the doubly degenerate e orbitals. (There are also three antibonding orbitals of the same species.) 1 Write down a table with columns headed by the symmetry operations of the group. 2 In the first row write down the characters of the symmetry species we want to analyse. 3 In the second row, write down the characters of the irreducible representation Γ we are interested in. 4 Multiply the two rows together, add the products together, and divide by the order of the group. The resulting number is the number of times Γ occurs in the decomposition. Illustration 12.1 To find whether A1 occurs in a direct product To find whether A1 does indeed occur in the product with characters 8, −2, −6, 4 in C2v, we draw up the following table: E C2v σv σ′v h = 4 (the order of the group) f1f2 8 −2 −6 4 (the characters of the product) A1 1 1 1 1 (the symmetry species we are interested in) 8 −2 −6 4 (the product of the two sets of characters) The sum of the numbers in the last line is 4; when that number is divided by the order of the group, we get 1, so A1 occurs once in the decomposition. When the procedure is repeated for all four symmetry species, we find that f1f2 spans A1 + 2A2 + 5B2. Self-test 12.5 Does A2 occur among the symmetry species of the irreducible representations spanned by a product with characters 7, −3, −1, 5 in the group C2v? [No] (b) Orbitals with nonzero overlap The rules just given let us decide which atomic orbitals may have nonzero overlap in a molecule. We have seen that sN may have nonzero overlap with s1 (the combination sA + sB + sC), so bonding and antibonding molecular orbitals can form from (sN, s1) overlap (Fig. 12.28). The general rule is that only orbitals of the same symmetry species may have nonzero overlap, so only orbitals of the same symmetry species form bonding and antibonding combinations. It should be recalled from Chapter 11 that the selection of atomic orbitals that had mutual nonzero overlap is the central and initial step in the construction of molecular orbitals by the LCAO procedure. We are therefore at the point of contact between group theory and the material introduced in that chapter. The molecular orbitals formed from a particular set of atomic orbitals with nonzero overlap are labelled with the lowercase letter corresponding to the symmetry species. Thus, the (sN, s1)-overlap orbitals are called a1 orbitals (or a1*, if we wish to emphasize that they are antibonding). The linear combinations s2 = 2sa − sb − sc and s3 = sb − sc have symmetry species E. Does the N atom have orbitals that have nonzero overlap with them (and give rise to e molecular orbitals)? Intuition (as supported by Figs. 12.28b and c) suggests that N2px and N2py should be suitable. We can confirm this conclusion by noting that the character table shows that, in C3v, the functions x and y jointly belong to the symmetry species E. Therefore, N2px and N2py also belong to E, so may have nonzero overlap with s2 and s3. This conclusion can be verified by multiplying the characters 422 12 MOLECULAR SYMMETRY and finding that the product of characters can be expressed as the decomposition E × E = A1 + A2 + E. The two e orbitals that result are shown in Fig. 12.28 (there are also two antibonding e orbitals). We can see the power of the method by exploring whether any d orbitals on the central atom can take part in bonding. As explained earlier, reference to the C3v character table shows that dz2 has A1 symmetry and that the pairs (dx2 −y2, dxy) and (dyz,dzx) each transform as E. It follows that molecular orbitals may be formed by (s1,dz2) overlap and by overlap of the s2,s3 combinations with the E d orbitals. Whether or not the d orbitals are in fact important is a question group theory cannot answer because the extent of their involvement depends on energy considerations, not symmetry. Example 12.5 Determining which orbitals can contribute to bonding The four H1s orbitals of methane span A1 + T2. With which of the C atom orbitals can they overlap? What bonding pattern would be possible if the C atom had d orbitals available? Method Refer to the Td character table (in the Data section) and look for s, p, and d orbitals spanning A1 or T2. Answer An s orbital spans A1, so it may have nonzero overlap with the A1 combination of H1s orbitals. The C2p orbitals span T2, so they may have nonzero overlap with the T2 combination. The dxy, dyz, and dzx orbitals span T2, so they may overlap the same combination. Neither of the other two d orbitals span A1 (they span E), so they remain nonbonding orbitals. It follows that in methane there are (C2s,H1s)overlap a1 orbitals and (C2p,H1s)-overlap t2 orbitals. The C3d orbitals might contribute to the latter. The lowest energy configuration is probably a1 2 t2 6 , with all bonding orbitals occupied. Self-test 12.6 Consider the octahedral SF6 molecule, with the bonding arising from overlap of S orbitals and a 2p orbital on each F directed towards the central S atom. The latter span A1g + Eg + T1u. What s orbitals have nonzero overlap? Suggest what the ground-state configuration is likely to be. [3s(A1g), 3p(T1u), 3d(Eg); a2 1gt6 1ue4 g] (c) Symmetry-adapted linear combinations So far, we have only asserted the forms of the linear combinations (such as s1, etc.) that have a particular symmetry. Group theory also provides machinery that takes an arbitrary basis, or set of atomic orbitals (sA, etc.), as input and generates combinations of the specified symmetry. Because these combinations are adapted to the symmetry of the molecule, they are called symmetry-adapted linear combinations (SALC). Symmetry-adapted linear combinations are the building blocks of LCAO molecular orbitals, for they include combinations such as those used to construct molecular orbitals in benzene. The construction of SALCs is the first step in any molecular orbital treatment of molecules. The technique for building SALCs is derived by using the full power of group theory. We shall not show the derivation (see Further reading), which is very lengthy, but present the main conclusions as a set of rules: 1 Construct a table showing the effect of each operation on each orbital of the original basis. 12.6 VANISHING INTEGRALS AND SELECTION RULES 423 2 To generate the combination of a specified symmetry species, take each column in turn and: (i) Multiply each member of the column by the character of the corresponding operation. (ii) Add together all the orbitals in each column with the factors as determined in (i). (iii) Divide the sum by the order of the group. For example, from the (sN,sA,sB,sC) basis in NH3 we form the table shown in the margin. To generate the A1 combination, we take the characters for A1 (1,1,1,1,1,1); then rules (i) and (ii) lead to ψ ∝ sN + sN + · · · = 6sN The order of the group (the number of elements) is 6, so the combination of A1 symmetry that can be generated from sN is sN itself. Applying the same technique to the column under sA gives ψ = 1 –6(sA + sB + sC + sA + sB + sC ) = 1 –3(sA + sB + sC) The same combination is built from the other two columns, so they give no further information. The combination we have just formed is the s1 combination we used before (apart from the numerical factor). We now form the overall molecular orbital by forming a linear combination of all the SALCs of the specified symmetry species. In this case, therefore, the a1 molecular orbital is ψ = cNsN + c1s1 This is as far as group theory can take us. The coefficients are found by solving the Schrödinger equation; they do not come directly from the symmetry of the system. We run into a problem when we try to generate an SALC of symmetry species E, because, for representations of dimension 2 or more, the rules generate sums of SALCs. This problem can be illustrated as follows. In C3v, the E characters are 2, −1, −1, 0, 0, 0, so the column under sN gives ψ = 1 –6(2sN − sN − sN + 0 + 0 + 0 ) = 0 The other columns give 1 –6(2sA − sB − sC) 1 –6(2sB − sA − sC) 1 –6(2sC − sB − sA) However, any one of these three expressions can be expressed as a sum of the other two (they are not ‘linearly independent’). The difference of the second and third gives 1 –2(sB − sC), and this combination and the first, 1 –6(2sA − sB − sC) are the two (now linearly independent) SALCs we have used in the discussion of e orbitals. 12.6 Vanishing integrals and selection rules Integrals of the form I = Ύf1f2 f3dτ (12.8) are also common in quantum mechanics for they include matrix elements of operators (Section 8.5d), and it is important to know when they are necessarily zero. For the integral to be nonzero, the product f1 f2 f3 must span A1 (or its equivalent) or contain a component that spans A1. To test whether this is so, the characters of all three functions are multiplied together in the same way as in the rules set out above. Original basis sN sA sB sC Under E sN sA sB sC C3 + sN sB sC sA C3 − sN sC sA sB σv sN sA sC sB σv′ sN sB sA sC σv″ sN sC sB sA 424 12 MOLECULAR SYMMETRY Forbidden Forbidden x-polarized x-polarized A1 A2 B1 B2 y-polarized Fig. 12.29 The polarizations of the allowed transitions in a C2v molecule. The shading indicates the structure of the orbitals of the specified symmetry species. The perspective view of the molecule makes it look rather like a door stop; however, from the side, each ‘door stop’ is in fact an isosceles triangle. Example 12.6 Deciding if an integral must be zero (2) Does the integral ∫(3dz2)x(3dxy)dτ vanish in a C2v molecule? Method We must refer to the C2v character table (Table 12.2) and the characters of the irreducible representations spanned by 3z2 − r2 (the form of the dz2 orbital), x, and xy; then we can use the procedure set out above (with one more row of multiplication). Answer We draw up the following table: E C2 σv σ′v f3 = dxy 1 1 −1 −1 A2 f2 = x 1 −1 1 −1 B1 f1 = dz2 1 1 1 1 A1 f1f2f3 1 −1 −1 1 The characters are those of B2. Therefore, the integral is necessarily zero. Self-test 12.7 Does the integral ∫(2px)(2py)(2pz)dτ necessarily vanish in an octahedral environment? [No] We saw in Chapters 9 and 10, and will see in more detail in Chapters 13 and 14, that the intensity of a spectral line arising from a molecular transition between some initial state with wavefunction ψi and a final state with wavefunction ψf depends on the (electric) transition dipole moment, µfi. The z-component of this vector is defined through µz,fi = −eΎψf*zψi dτ [12.9] where −e is the charge of the electron. The transition moment has the form of the integral in eqn 12.8, so, once we know the symmetry species of the states, we can use group theory to formulate the selection rules for the transitions. As an example, we investigate whether an electron in an a1 orbital in H2O (which belongs to the group C2v) can make an electric dipole transition to a b1 orbital (Fig. 12.29). We must examine all three components of the transition dipole moment, and take f2 in eqn 12.8 as x, y, and z in turn. Reference to the C2v character table shows that these components transform as B1, B2, and A1, respectively. The three calculations run as follows: x-component y-component z-component E C2 σv σ′v E C2 σv σ′v E C2 sv s′v f3 1 −1 1 −1 1 −1 1 −1 1 −1 1 −1B1 f2 1 −1 1 −1 1 −1 −1 1 1 1 1 1 f1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1A1 f1 f2 f3 1 1 1 1 1 1 −1 −1 1 −1 1 −1 Only the first product (with f2 = x) spans A1, so only the x-component of the transition dipole moment may be nonzero. Therefore, we conclude that the electric dipole CHECKLIST OF KEY IDEAS 425 Checklist of key ideas 1. A symmetry operation is an action that leaves an object looking the same after it has been carried out. 2. A symmetry element is a point, line, or plane with respect to which a symmetry operation is performed. 3. A point group is a group of symmetry operations that leaves at least one common point unchanged. A space group, a group of symmetry operations that includes translation through space. 4. The notation for point groups commonly used for molecules and solids is summarized in Table 12.1. 5. To be polar, a molecule must belong to Cn, Cnv, or Cs (and have no higher symmetry). 6. A molecule may be chiral only if it does not possess an axis of improper rotation, Sn. 7. A representative D(X) is a matrix that brings about the transformation of the basis under the operation X. The basis is the set of functions on which the representative acts. 8. A character, χ, is the sum of the diagonal elements of a matrix representative. 9. A character table characterizes the different symmetry types possible in the point group. 10. In a reduced representation all the matrices have blockdiagonal form. An irreducible representation cannot be reduced further. 11. Symmetry species are the labels for the irreducible representations of a group. 12. Decomposition of the direct product is the reduction of a product of symmetry species to a sum of symmetry species, Γ × Γ ′ = Γ (1) + Γ (2) + · · · transitions between a1 and b1 are allowed. We can go on to state that the radiation emitted (or absorbed) is x-polarized and has its electric field vector in the x-direction, because that form of radiation couples with the x–component of a transition dipole. Example 12.7 Deducing a selection rule Is px → py an allowed transition in a tetrahedral environment? Method We must decide whether the product pyqpx, with q = x, y, or z, spans A1 by using the Td character table. Answer The procedure works out as follows: E 8C3 3C2 6σd 6S4 f3(py) 3 0 −1 −1 1 T2 f2(q) 3 0 −1 −1 1 T2 f1(px) 3 0 −1 −1 1 T2 f1f2f3 27 0 −1 −1 1 We can use the decomposition procedure described in Section 12.5a to deduce that A1 occurs (once) in this set of characters, so px → py is allowed. A more detailed analysis (using the matrix representatives rather than the characters) shows that only q = z gives an integral that may be nonzero, so the transition is z-polarized. That is, the electromagnetic radiation involved in the transition has its electric vector aligned in the z-direction. Self-test 12.8 What are the allowed transitions, and their polarizations, of a b1 electron in a C4v molecule? [b1 → b1(z); b1 → e(x,y)] The following chapters will show many more examples of the systematic use of symmetry. We shall see that the techniques of group theory greatly simplify the analysis of molecular structure and spectra. 426 12 MOLECULAR SYMMETRY 13. For an integral ∫f1f2 dτ to be nonzero, the integrand f1 f2 must have the symmetry species A1 (or its equivalent in the specific molecular point group). 14. A symmetry-adapted linear combination (SALC) is a combination of atomic orbitals adapted to the symmetry of the molecule and used as the building blocks for LCAO molecular orbitals. 15. Allowed and forbidden spectroscopic transitions can be identified by considering the symmetry criteria for the nonvanishing of the transition moment between the initial and final states. Further reading Articles and texts P.W. Atkins and R.S. Friedman, Molecular quantum mechanics. Oxford University Press (2005). F.A. Cotton, Chemical applications of group theory. Wiley, New York (1990). R. Drago, Physical methods for chemists. Saunders, Philadelphia (1992). D.C. Harris and M.D. Bertollucci, Symmetry and spectroscopy: an introduction to vibrational and electronic spectroscopy. Dover, New York (1989). S.F.A. Kettle, Symmetry and structure: readable group theory for chemists. Wiley, New York (1995). Sources of data and information G.L. Breneman, Crystallographic symmetry point group notation flow chart. J. Chem. Educ. 64, 216 (1987). P.W. Atkins, M.S. Child, and C.S.G. Phillips, Tables for group theory. Oxford University Press (1970). Discussion questions 12.1 Explain how a molecule is assigned to a point group. 12.2 List the symmetry operations and the corresponding symmetry elements of the point groups. 12.3 Explain the symmetry criteria that allow a molecule to be polar. 12.4 Explain the symmetry criteria that allow a molecule to be optically active. 12.5 Explain what is meant by (a) a representative and (b) a representation in the context of group theory. 12.6 Explain the construction and content of a character table. 12.7 Explain how spectroscopic selection rules arise and how they are formulated by using group theory. 12.8 Outline how a direct product is expressed as a direct sum and how to decide whether the totally symmetric irreducible representation is present in the direct product. Exercises 12.1a The CH3Cl molecule belongs to the point group C3v. List the symmetry elements of the group and locate them in the molecule. 12.1b The CCl4 molecule belongs to the point group Td. List the symmetry elements of the group and locate them in the molecule. 12.2a Which of the following molecules may be polar? (a) pyridine (C2v), (b) nitroethane (Cs), (c) gas-phase HgBr2 (D∞h), (d) B3N3N6 (D3h). 12.2b Which of the following molecules may be polar? (a) CH3Cl (C3v), (b) HW2(CO)10 (D4h), (c) SnCl4 (Td). 12.3a Use symmetry properties to determine whether or not the integral ∫pxzpzdτ is necessarily zero in a molecule with symmetry C4v. 12.3b Use symmetry properties to determine whether or not the integral ∫pxzpzdτ is necessarily zero in a molecule with symmetry D6h. 12.4a Show that the transition A1 → A2 is forbidden for electric dipole transitions in a C3v molecule. 12.4b Is the transition A1g → E2u forbidden for electric dipole transitions in a D6h molecule? 12.5a Show that the function xy has symmetry species B2 in the group C4v. 12.5b Show that the function xyz has symmetry species A1 in the group D2. 12.6a Molecules belonging to the point groups D2h or C3h cannot be chiral. Which elements of these groups rule out chirality? 12.6b Molecules belonging to the point groups Th or Td cannot be chiral. Which elements of these groups rule out chirality? 12.7a The group D2 consists of the elements E, C2, C2′, and C2″, where the three twofold rotations are around mutually perpendicular axes. Construct the group multiplication table. PROBLEMS 427 12.7b The group C4v consists of the elements E, 2C4, C2, and 2σv, 2σd. Construct the group multiplication table. 12.8a Identify the point groups to which the following objects belong: (a) a sphere, (b) an isosceles triangle, (c) an equilateral triangle, (d) an unsharpened cylindrical pencil. 12.8b Identify the point groups to which the following objects belong: (a) a sharpened cylindrical pencil, (b) a three-bladed propellor, (c) a four-legged table, (d) yourself (approximately). 12.9a List the symmetry elements of the following molecules and name the point groups to which they belong: (a) NO2, (b) N2O, (c) CHCl3, (d) CH2=CH2, (e) cis-CHBr=CHBr, (f) trans-CHCl=CHCl. 12.9b List the symmetry elements of the following molecules and name the point groups to which they belong: (a) naphthalene, (b) anthracene, (c) the three dichlorobenzenes. 12.10a Assign (a) cis-dichloroethene and (b) trans-dichloroethene to point groups. 12.10b Assign the following molecules to point groups: (a) HF, (b) IF7 (pentagonal bipyramid), (c) XeO2F2 (see-saw), (d) Fe2(CO)9 (22), (e) cubane, C8H8, (f) tetrafluorocubane, C8H4F4 (23). 12.11a Which of the molecules in Exercises 12.9a and 12.10a can be (a) polar, (b) chiral? 12.11b Which of the molecules in Exercises 12.9b and 12.10b can be (a) polar, (b) chiral? 12.12a Consider the C2v molecule NO2. The combination px(A) − px(B) of the two O atoms (with x perpendicular to the plane) spans A2. Is there any orbital of the central N atom that can have a nonzero overlap with that combination of O orbitals? What would be the case in SO2, where 3d orbitals might be available? 12.12b Consider the C3v ion NO3 − . Is there any orbital of the central N atom that can have a nonzero overlap with the combination 2pz(A) − pz(B) − pz(C) of the three O atoms (with z perpendicular to the plane). What would be the case in SO3, where 3d orbitals might be available? 12.13a The ground state of NO2 is A1 in the group C2v. To what excited states may it be excited by electric dipole transitions, and what polarization of light is it necessary to use? 12.13b The ClO2 molecule (which belongs to the group C2v) was trapped in a solid. Its ground state is known to be B1. Light polarized parallel to the y-axis (parallel to the OO separation) excited the molecule to an upper state. What is the symmetry of that state? 12.14a What states of (a) benzene, (b) naphthalene may be reached by electric dipole transitions from their (totally symmetrical) ground states? 12.14b What states of (a) anthracene, (b) coronene (24) may be reached by electric dipole transitions from their (totally symmetrical) ground states? 12.15a Write f1 = sin θ and f2 = cos θ, and show by symmetry arguments using the group Cs that the integral of their product over a symmetrical range around θ = 0 is zero. 12.15b Determine whether the integral over f1 and f2 in Exercise 12.15a is zero over a symmetrical range about θ = 0 in the group C3v. Problems* 12.1 List the symmetry elements of the following molecules and name the point groups to which they belong: (a) staggered CH3CH3, (b) chair and boat cyclohexane, (c) B2H6, (d) [Co(en)3]3+ , where en is ethylenediamine (ignore its detailed structure), (e) crown-shaped S8. Which of these molecules can be (i) polar, (ii) chiral? 12.2 The group C2h consists of the elements E, C2, σh, i. Construct the group multiplication table and find an example of a molecule that belongs to the group. 12.3 The group D2h has a C2 axis perpendicular to the principal axis and a horizontal mirror plane. Show that the group must therefore have a centre of inversion. 12.4 Consider the H2O molecule, which belongs to the group C2v. Take as a basis the two H1s orbitals and the four valence orbital of the O atom and set up the 6 × 6 matrices that represent the group in this basis. Confirm by explicit matrix multiplication that the group multiplications (a) C2σv = σv′ and (b) σvσv′ = C2. Confirm, by calculating the traces of the matrices: (a) that symmetry elements in the same class have the same character, (b) that the representation is reducible, and (c) that the basis spans 3A1 + B1 + 2B2. 12.5 Confirm that the z-component of orbital angular momentum is a basis for an irreducible representation of A2 symmetry in C3v. 12.6 The (one-dimensional) matrices D(C3) = 1 and D(C2) = 1, and D(C3) = 1 and D(C2) = −1 both represent the group multiplication C3C2 = C6 in the group C6v with D(C6) = +1 and −1, respectively. Use the character table to confirm these remarks. What are the representatives of σv and σd in each case? 12.7 Construct the multiplication table of the Pauli spin matrices, σ, and the 2 × 2 unit matrix: * Problems denoted with the symbol ‡ were supplied by Charles Trapp and Carmen Giunta. CO Fe CO 22 F F F F H H H H 23 428 12 MOLECULAR SYMMETRY σx = σy = σz = σ0 = Do the four matrices form a group under multiplication? 12.8 What irreducible representations do the four H1s orbitals of CH4 span? Are there s and p orbitals of the central C atom that may form molecular orbitals with them? Could d orbitals, even if they were present on the C atom, play a role in orbital formation in CH4? 12.9 Suppose that a methane molecule became distorted to (a) C3v symmetry by the lengthening of one bond, (b) C2v symmetry, by a kind of scissors action in which one bond angle opened and another closed slightly. Would more d orbitals become available for bonding? 12.10‡ B.A. Bovenzi and G.A. Pearse, Jr. (J. Chem. Soc. Dalton Trans., 2763 (1997)) synthesized coordination compounds of the tridentate ligand pyridine-2,6-diamidoxime (C7H9N5O2, 25). Reaction with NiSO4 produced a complex in which two of the essentially planar ligands are bonded at right angles to a single Ni atom. Name the point group and the symmetry operations of the resulting [Ni(C7H9N5O2)2]2+ complex cation. 12.11‡ R. Eujen, B. Hoge, and D.J. Brauer (Inorg. Chem. 36, 1464 (1997)) prepared and characterized several square-planar Ag(III) complex anions. In the complex anion [trans-Ag(CF3)2(CN)2]− , the Ag-CN groups are collinear. (a) Assuming free rotation of the CF3 groups (that is, disregarding the AgCF and AgCH angles), name the point group of this complex anion. (b) Now suppose the CF3 groups cannot rotate freely (because the ion was in a solid, for example). Structure (26) shows a plane that bisects the NC-Ag-CN axis and is perpendicular to it. Name the point group of the complex if each CF3 group has a CF bond in that plane (so the CF3 groups do not point to either CN group preferentially) and the CF3 groups are (i) staggered, (ii) eclipsed. 12.12‡ A computational study by C.J. Marsden (Chem. Phys. Lett. 245, 475 (1995)) of AMx compounds, where A is in Group 14 of the periodic table and M is an alkali metal, shows several deviations from the most symmetric structures for each formula. For example, most of the AM4 structures were not tetrahedral but had two distinct values for MAM bond angles. They could be NC CN CF3 CF3 Ag 26 1 0 0 1 ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ 1 0 0 1− ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ 0 0 −⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ i i 0 1 1 0 ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ derived from a tetrahedron by a distortion shown in (27). (a) What is the point group of the distorted tetrahedron? (b) What is the symmetry species of the distortion considered as a vibration in the new, less symmetric group? Some AM6 structures are not octahedral, but could be derived from an octahedron by translating a C-M-C axis as in (28). (c) What is the point group of the distorted octahedron? (d) What is the symmetry species of the distortion considered as a vibration in the new, less symmetric group? 12.13 The algebraic forms of the f orbitals are a radial function multiplied by one of the factors (a) z(5z2 − 3r2 ), (b) y(5y2 − 3r2 ), (c) x(5x2 − 3r2 ), (d) z(x2 − y2 ), (e) y(x2 − z2 ), (f) x(z2 − y2 ), (g) xyz. Identify the irreducible representations spanned by these orbitals in (a) C2v, (b) C3v, (c) Td, (d) Oh. Consider a lanthanide ion at the centre of (a) a tetrahedral complex, (b) an octahedral complex. What sets of orbitals do the seven f orbitals split into? 12.14 Does the product xyz necessarily vanish when integrated over (a) a cube, (b) a tetrahedron, (c) a hexagonal prism, each centred on the origin? 12.15 The NO2 molecule belongs to the group C2v, with the C2 axis bisecting the ONO angle. Taking as a basis the N2s, N2p, and O2p orbitals, identify the irreducible representations they span, and construct the symmetry-adapted linear combinations. 12.16 Construct the symmetry-adapted linear combinations of C2pz orbitals for benzene, and use them to calculate the Hückel secular determinant. This procedure leads to equations that are much easier to solve than using the original orbitals, and show that the Hückel orbitals are those specified in Section 11.6d. 12.17 The phenanthrene molecule (29) belongs to the group C2v with the C2 axis perpendicular to the molecular plane. (a) Classify the irreducible representations spanned by the carbon 2pz orbitals and find their symmetryadapted linear combinations. (b) Use your results from part (a) to calculate the Hückel secular determinant. (c) What states of phenanthrene may be reached by electric dipole transitions from its (totally symmetrical) ground state? 12.18‡ In a spectroscopic study of C60, F. Negri, G. Orlandi, and F. Zerbetto (J. Phys. Chem. 100, 10849 (1996)) assigned peaks in the fluorescence spectrum. The molecule has icosahedral symmetry (Ih). The ground electronic state is A1g, and the lowest-lying excited states are T1g and Gg. (a) Are photoninduced transitions allowed from the ground state to either of these excited states? Explain your answer. (b) What if the transition is accompanied by a vibration that breaks the parity? 27 28 PROBLEMS 429 Applications: to astrophysics and biology 12.19‡ The H3 + molecular ion, which plays an important role in chemical reactions occurring in interstellar clouds, is known to be equilateral triangular. (a) Identify the symmetry elements and determine the point group of this molecule. (b) Take as a basis for a representation of this molecule the three H1s orbitals and set up the matrices that group in this basis. (c) Obtain the group multiplication table by explicit multiplication of the matrices. (d) Determine if the representation is reducible and, if so, give the irreducible representations obtained. 12.20‡ The H3 + molecular ion has recently been found in the interstellar medium and in the atmospheres of Jupiter, Saturn, and Uranus. The H4 analogues have not yet been found, and the square planar structure is thought to be unstable with respect to vibration. Take as a basis for a representation of the point group of this molecule the four H1s orbitals and determine if this representation is reducible. 12.21 Some linear polyenes, of which β-carotene is an example, are important biological co-factors that participate in processes as diverse as the absorption of solar energy in photosynthesis (Impact I23.2) and protection against harmful biological oxidations. Use as a model of β-carotene a linear polyene containing 22 conjugated C atoms. (a) To what point group does this model of β-carotene belong? (b) Classify the irreducible representations spanned by the carbon 2pz orbitals and find their symmetry-adapted linear combinations. (c) Use your results from part (b) to calculate the Hückel secular determinant. (d) What states of this model of β-carotene may be reached by electric dipole transitions from its (totally symmetrical) ground state? 12.22 The chlorophylls that participate in photosynthesis (Impact I24.2) and the haem groups of cytochromes (Impact I7.2) are derived from the porphine dianion group (30), which belongs to the D4h point group. The ground electronic state is A1g and the lowest-lying excited state is Eu. Is a photoninduced transition allowed from the ground state to the excited state? Explain your answer. Molecular spectroscopy 1: rotational and vibrational spectra The general strategy we adopt in the chapter is to set up expressions for the energy levels of molecules and then apply selection rules and considerations of populations to infer the form of spectra. Rotational energy levels are considered first, and we see how to derive expressions for their values and how to interpret rotational spectra in terms of molecular dimensions. Not all molecules can occupy all rotational states: we see the experimental evidence for this restriction and its explanation in terms of nuclear spin and the Pauli principle. Next, we consider the vibrational energy levels of diatomic molecules, and see that we can use the properties of harmonic oscillators developed in Chapter 9. Then we consider polyatomic molecules and find that their vibrations may be discussed as though they consisted of a set of independent harmonic oscillators, so the same approach as employed for diatomic molecules may be used. We also see that the symmetry properties of the vibrations of polyatomic molecules are helpful for deciding which modes of vibration can be studied spectroscopically. The origin of spectral lines in molecular spectroscopy is the absorption, emission, or scattering of a photon when the energy of a molecule changes. The difference from atomic spectroscopy is that the energy of a molecule can change not only as a result of electronic transitions but also because it can undergo changes of rotational and vibrational state. Molecular spectra are therefore more complex than atomic spectra. However, they also contain information relating to more properties, and their analysis leads to values of bond strengths, lengths, and angles. They also provide a way of determining a variety of molecular properties, particularly molecular dimensions, shapes, and dipole moments. Molecular spectroscopy is also useful to astrophysicists and environmental scientists, for the chemical composition of interstellar space and of planetary atmospheres can be inferred from their rotational, vibrational, and electronic spectra. Pure rotational spectra, in which only the rotational state of a molecule changes, can be observed in the gas phase. Vibrational spectra of gaseous samples show features that arise from rotational transitions that accompany the excitation of vibration. Electronic spectra, which are described in Chapter 14, show features arising from simultaneous vibrational and rotational transitions. The simplest way of dealing with these complexities is to tackle each type of transition in turn, and then to see how simultaneous changes affect the appearance of spectra. General features of spectroscopy 13.1 Experimental techniques 13.2 The intensities of spectral lines 13.3 Linewidths I13.1 Impact on astrophysics: Rotational and vibrational spectroscopy of interstellar space Pure rotation spectra 13.4 Moments of inertia 13.5 The rotational energy levels 13.6 Rotational transitions 13.7 Rotational Raman spectra 13.8 Nuclear statistics and rotational states The vibrations of diatomic molecules 13.9 Molecular vibrations 13.10 Selection rules 13.11 Anharmonicity 13.12 Vibration–rotation spectra 13.13 Vibrational Raman spectra of diatomic molecules The vibrations of polyatomic molecules 13.14 Normal modes 13.15 Infrared absorption spectra of polyatomic molecules I13.2 Impact on environmental science: Global warming 13.16 Vibrational Raman spectra of polyatomic molecules I13.3 Impact on biochemistry: Vibrational microscopy 13.17 Symmetry aspects of molecular vibrations Checklist of key ideas Further reading Further information 13.1: Spectrometers Further information 13.2: Selection rules for rotational and vibrational spectroscopy Discussion questions Exercises Problems 13 13.1 EXPERIMENTAL TECHNIQUES 431 General features of spectroscopy All types of spectra have some features in common, and we examine these first. In emission spectroscopy, a molecule undergoes a transition from a state of high energy E1 to a state of lower energy E2 and emits the excess energy as a photon. In absorption spectroscopy, the net absorption of nearly monochromatic (single frequency) incident radiation is monitored as the radiation is swept over a range of frequencies. We say net absorption, because it will become clear that, when a sample is irradiated, both absorption and emission at a given frequency are stimulated, and the detector measures the difference, the net absorption. The energy, hν, of the photon emitted or absorbed, and therefore the frequency ν of the radiation emitted or absorbed, is given by the Bohr frequency condition, hν = |E1 − E2 | (eqn 8.10). Emission and absorption spectroscopy give the same information about energy level separations, but practical considerations generally determine which technique is employed. We shall discuss emission spectroscopy in Chapter 14; here we focus on absorption spectroscopy, which is widely employed in studies of electronic transitions, molecular rotations, and molecular vibrations. In Chapter 9 we saw that transitions between electronic energy levels are stimulated by or emit ultraviolet, visible, or near-infrared radiation. Vibrational and rotational transitions, the focus of the discussion in this chapter, can be induced in two ways. First, the direct absorption or emission of infrared radiation can cause changes in vibrational energy levels, whereas absorption or emission of microwave radiation gives information about rotational energy levels. Second, vibrational and rotational energy levels can be explored by examining the frequencies present in the radiation scattered by molecules in Ramanspectroscopy. About 1 in 107 of the incident photons collide with the molecules, give up some of their energy, and emerge with a lower energy. These scattered photons constitute the lower-frequency Stokesradiation from the sample (Fig. 13.1). Other incident photons may collect energy from the molecules (if they are already excited), and emerge as higher-frequency anti-Stokes radiation. The component of radiation scattered without change of frequency is called Rayleigh radiation. 13.1 Experimental techniques A spectrometer is an instrument that detects the characteristics of light scattered, emitted, or absorbed by atoms and molecules. Figure 13.2 shows the general layouts of absorption and emission spectrometers operating in the ultraviolet and visible ranges. Radiation from an appropriate source is directed toward a sample. In most Energy Incident radiation Scattered radiation Fig. 13.1 In Raman spectroscopy, an incident photon is scattered from a molecule with either an increase in frequency (if the radiation collects energy from the molecule) or—as shown here for the case of scattered Stokes radiation—with a lower frequency if it loses energy to the molecule. The process can be regarded as taking place by an excitation of the molecule to a wide range of states (represented by the shaded band), and the subsequent return of the molecule to a lower state; the net energy change is then carried away by the photon. Sample Reference Source Detector Grating Beam combiner Source Detector Sample Scattered radiation (a) (b) Fig. 13.2 Two examples of spectrometers: (a) the layout of an absorption spectrometer, used primarily for studies in the ultraviolet and visible ranges, in which the exciting beams of radiation pass alternately through a sample and a reference cell, and the detector is synchronized with them so that the relative absorption can be determined, and (b) a simple emission spectrometer, where light emitted or scattered by the sample is detected at right angles to the direction of propagation of an incident beam of radiation. 432 13 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 1: ROTATIONAL AND VIBRATIONAL SPECTRA spectrometers, light transmitted, emitted, or scattered by the sample is collected by mirrors or lenses and strikes a dispersing element that separates radiation into different frequencies. The intensity of light at each frequency is then analysed by a suitable detector. In a typical Raman spectroscopy experiment, a monochromatic incident laser beam is passed through the sample and the radiation scattered from the front face of the sample is monitored (Fig. 13.3). This detection geometry allows for the study of gases, pure liquids, solutions, suspensions, and solids. Modern spectrometers, particularly those operating in the infrared and nearinfrared, now almost always use Fourier transform techniques of spectral detection and analysis. The heart of a Fourier transform spectrometer is a Michelson interferometer, a device for analysing the frequencies present in a composite signal. The total signal from a sample is like a chord played on a piano, and the Fourier transform of the signal is equivalent to the separation of the chord into its individual notes, its spectrum. 13.2 The intensities of spectral lines The ratio of the transmitted intensity, I, to the incident intensity, I0, at a given frequency is called the transmittance, T, of the sample at that frequency: T = [13.1] It is found empirically that the transmitted intensity varies with the length, l, of the sample and the molar concentration, [J], of the absorbing species J in accord with the Beer–Lambert law: I = I010−ε[J]l (13.2) The quantity ε is called the molar absorption coefficient (formerly, and still widely, the ‘extinction coefficient’). The molar absorption coefficient depends on the frequency of the incident radiation and is greatest where the absorption is most intense. Its dimensions are 1/(concentration × length), and it is normally convenient to express it in cubic decimetres per mole per centimetre (dm3 mol−1 cm−1 ). Alternative units are square centimetres per mole (cm2 mol−1 ). This change of units demonstrates that ε may be regarded as a molar cross-section for absorption and, the greater the crosssectional area of the molecule for absorption, the greater its ability to block the passage of the incident radiation. To simplify eqn 13.2, we introduce the absorbance, A, of the sample at a given wavenumber as A = log or A = −log T [13.3] Then the Beer–Lambert law becomes A = ε[J]l (13.4) The product ε[J]l was known formerly as the optical density of the sample. Equation 13.4 suggests that, to achieve sufficient absorption, path lengths through gaseous samples must be very long, of the order of metres, because concentrations are low. Long path lengths are achieved by multiple passage of the beam between parallel mirrors at each end of the sample cavity. Conversely, path lengths through liquid samples can be significantly shorter, of the order of millimetres or centimetres. I0 I I I0 Laser Sample cell Monochromator or interferometer Detector Fig. 13.3 A common arrangement adopted in Raman spectroscopy. A laser beam first passes through a lens and then through a small hole in a mirror with a curved reflecting surface. The focused beam strikes the sample and scattered light is both deflected and focused by the mirror. The spectrum is analysed by a monochromator or an interferometer. Comment 13.1 The principles of operation of radiation sources, dispersing elements, Fourier transform spectrometers, and detectors are described in Further information 13.1. 13.2 THE INTENSITIES OF SPECTRAL LINES 433 Molarabsorption coefficient, Area = integrated absorption coefficient Wavenumber,~n e Fig. 13.4 The integrated absorption coefficient of a transition is the area under a plot of the molar absorption coefficient against the wavenumber of the incident radiation. Justification 13.1 The Beer–Lambert law The Beer–Lambert law is an empirical result. However, it is simple to account for its form. The reduction in intensity, dI, that occurs when light passes through a layer of thickness dl containing an absorbing species J at a molar concentration [J] is proportional to the thickness of the layer, the concentration of J, and the intensity, I, incident on the layer (because the rate of absorption is proportional to the intensity, see below). We can therefore write dI = −κ[J]Idl where κ (kappa) is the proportionality coefficient, or equivalently = −κ[J]dl This expression applies to each successive layer into which the sample can be regarded as being divided. Therefore, to obtain the intensity that emerges from a sample of thickness l when the intensity incident on one face of the sample is I0, we sum all the successive changes: Ύ I I0 = −κΎ l 0 [J]dl If the concentration is uniform, [J] is independent of location, and the expression integrates to ln = −κ[J]l This expression gives the Beer–Lambert law when the logarithm is converted to base 10 by using ln x = (ln 10)log x and replacing κ by ε ln 10. Illustration 13.1 Using the Beer–Lambert law The Beer–Lambert law implies that the intensity of electromagnetic radiation transmitted through a sample at a given wavenumber decreases exponentially with the sample thickness and the molar concentration. If the transmittance is 0.1 for a path length of 1 cm (corresponding to a 90 per cent reduction in intensity), then it would be (0.1)2 = 0.01 for a path of double the length (corresponding to a 99 per cent reduction in intensity overall). The maximum value of the molar absorption coefficient, εmax, is an indication of the intensity of a transition. However, as absorption bands generally spread over a range of wavenumbers, quoting the absorption coefficient at a single wavenumber might not give a true indication of the intensity of a transition. The integrated absorption coefficient, A, is the sum of the absorption coefficients over the entire band (Fig. 13.4), and corresponds to the area under the plot of the molar absorption coefficient against wavenumber: A = Ύband ε(#) d# [13.5] For lines of similar widths, the integrated absorption coefficients are proportional to the heights of the lines. I I0 dI I dI I 434 13 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 1: ROTATIONAL AND VIBRATIONAL SPECTRA (a) Absorption intensities Einstein identified three contributions to the transitions between states. Stimulated absorption is the transition from a low energy state to one of higher energy that is driven by the electromagnetic field oscillating at the transition frequency. We saw in Section 9.10 that the transition rate, w, is the rate of change of probability of the molecule being found in the upper state. We also saw that the more intense the electromagnetic field (the more intense the incident radiation), the greater the rate at which transitions are induced and hence the stronger the absorption by the sample (Fig. 13.5). Einstein wrote the transition rate as w = Bρ (13.6) The constant B is the Einstein coefficient of stimulated absorption and ρdν is the energy density of radiation in the frequency range ν to ν + dν, where ν is the frequency of the transition. When the molecule is exposed to black-body radiation from a source of temperature T, ρ is given by the Planck distribution (eqn 8.5): ρ = (13.7) For the time being, we can treat B as an empirical parameter that characterizes the transition: if B is large, then a given intensity of incident radiation will induce transitions strongly and the sample will be strongly absorbing. The totalrateofabsorption, W, the number of molecules excited during an interval divided by the duration of the interval, is the transition rate of a single molecule multiplied by the number of molecules N in the lower state: W = Nw. Einstein considered that the radiation was also able to induce the molecule in the upper state to undergo a transition to the lower state, and hence to generate a photon of frequency ν. Thus, he wrote the rate of this stimulated emission as w′ = B′ρ (13.8) where B′ is the Einstein coefficient of stimulated emission. Note that only radiation of the same frequency as the transition can stimulate an excited state to fall to a lower state. However, he realized that stimulated emission was not the only means by which the excited state could generate radiation and return to the lower state, and suggested that an excited state could undergo spontaneous emission at a rate that was independent of the intensity of the radiation (of any frequency) that is already present. Einstein therefore wrote the total rate of transition from the upper to the lower state as w′ = A + B′ρ (13.9) The constant A is the Einstein coefficient of spontaneous emission. The overall rate of emission is W′ = N′(A + B′ρ) (13.10) where N′ is the population of the upper state. As demonstrated in the Justification below, Einstein was able to show that the two coefficients of stimulated absorption and emission are equal, and that the coefficient of spontaneous emission is related to them by A = B (13.11) D F 8πhν3 c3 A C 8πhν3 /c3 ehν/kT − 1 Stimulatedabsorption Stimulatedemission Spontaneousemission Fig. 13.5 The processes that account for absorption and emission of radiation and the attainment of thermal equilibrium. The excited state can return to the lower state spontaneously as well as by a process stimulated by radiation already present at the transition frequency. Comment 13.2 The slight difference between the forms of the Planck distribution shown in eqns 8.5 and 13.7 stems from the fact that it is written here as ρdν, and dλ = (c/ν2 )dν. 13.2 THE INTENSITIES OF SPECTRAL LINES 435 Justification 13.2 The relation between the Einstein coefficients At thermal equilibrium, the total rates of emission and absorption are equal, so NBρ = N′(A + B′ρ) This expression rearranges into ρ = = = We have used the Boltzmann expression (Molecular interpretation 3.1) for the ratio of populations of states of energies E and E′ in the last step: = e−hν/kT hν = E′ − E This result has the same form as the Planck distribution (eqn 13.7), which describes the radiation density at thermal equilibrium. Indeed, when we compare the two expressions for ρ, we can conclude that B′ = B and that A is related to B by eqn 13.11. The growth of the importance of spontaneous emission with increasing frequency is a very important conclusion, as we shall see when we consider the operation of lasers (Section 14.5). The equality of the coefficients of stimulated emission and absorption implies that, if two states happen to have equal populations, then the rate of stimulated emission is equal to the rate of stimulated absorption, and there is then no net absorption. Spontaneous emission can be largely ignored at the relatively low frequencies of rotational and vibrational transitions, and the intensities of these transitions can be discussed in terms of stimulated emission and absorption. Then the net rate of absorption is given by Wnet = NBρ − N′B′ρ = (N − N′)Bρ (13.12) and is proportional to the population difference of the two states involved in the transition. (b) Selection rules and transition moments We met the concept of a ‘selection rule’ in Sections 10.3 and 12.6 as a statement about whether a transition is forbidden or allowed. Selection rules also apply to molecular spectra, and the form they take depends on the type of transition. The underlying classical idea is that, for the molecule to be able to interact with the electromagnetic field and absorb or create a photon of frequency ν, it must possess, at least transiently, a dipole oscillating at that frequency. We saw in Section 9.10 that this transient dipole is expressed quantum mechanically in terms of the transition dipole moment, µfi, between states ψi and ψf: µfi = Ύψf*¢ψidτ [13.13] where ¢ is the electric dipole moment operator. The size of the transition dipole can be regarded as a measure of the charge redistribution that accompanies a transition: a transition will be active (and generate or absorb photons) only if the accompanying charge redistribution is dipolar (Fig. 13.6). We know from time-dependent perturbation theory (Section 9.10) that the transition rate is proportional to |µfi|2 . It follows that the coefficient of stimulated absorption N′ N A/B ehν/kT − B′/B A/B N/N′ − B′/B N′A NB − N′B′ (a) (b) Fig. 13.6 (a) When a 1s electron becomes a 2s electron, there is a spherical migration of charge; there is no dipole moment associated with this migration of charge; this transition is electric-dipole forbidden. (b) In contrast, when a 1s electron becomes a 2p electron, there is a dipole associated with the charge migration; this transition is allowed. (There are subtle effects arising from the sign of the wavefunction that give the charge migration a dipolar character, which this diagram does not attempt to convey.) 436 13 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 1: ROTATIONAL AND VIBRATIONAL SPECTRA (and emission), and therefore the intensity of the transition, is also proportional to |µfi|2 . A detailed analysis gives B = (13.14) Only if the transition moment is nonzero does the transition contribute to the spectrum. It follows that, to identify the selection rules, we must establish the conditions for which µfi ≠ 0. A gross selection rule specifies the general features a molecule must have if it is to have a spectrum of a given kind. For instance, we shall see that a molecule gives a rotational spectrum only if it has a permanent electric dipole moment. This rule, and others like it for other types of transition, will be explained in the relevant sections of the chapter. A detailed study of the transition moment leads to the specific selection rules that express the allowed transitions in terms of the changes in quantum numbers. We have already encountered examples of specific selection rules when discussing atomic spectra (Section 10.3), such as the rule ∆l = ±1 for the angular momentum quantum number. 13.3 Linewidths A number of effects contribute to the widths of spectroscopic lines. Some contributions to linewidths can be modified by changing the conditions, and to achieve high resolutions we need to know how to minimize these contributions. Other contributions cannot be changed, and represent an inherent limitation on resolution. (a) Doppler broadening The study of gaseous samples is very important, as it can inform our understanding of atmospheric chemistry. In some cases, meaningful spectroscopic data can be obtained only from gaseous samples. For example, they are essential for rotational spectroscopy, for only in gases can molecules rotate freely. One important broadening process in gaseous samples is the Doppler effect, in which radiation is shifted in frequency when the source is moving towards or away from the observer. When a source emitting electromagnetic radiation of frequency ν moves with a speed s relative to an observer, the observer detects radiation of frequency νreceding = ν 1/2 νapproaching = ν 1/2 (13.15) where c is the speed of light (see Further reading for derivations). For nonrelativistic speeds (s << c), these expressions simplify to νreceding ≈ νapproaching ≈ (13.16) Molecules reach high speeds in all directions in a gas, and a stationary observer detects the corresponding Doppler-shifted range of frequencies. Some molecules approach the observer, some move away; some move quickly, others slowly. The detected spectral ‘line’ is the absorption or emission profile arising from all the resulting Doppler shifts. As shown in the following Justification, the profile reflects the distribution of molecular velocities parallel to the line of sight, which is a bell-shaped Gaussian curve. The Doppler line shape is therefore also a Gaussian (Fig. 13.7), and we show in the ν 1 − s/c ν 1 + s/c D F 1 + s/c 1 − s/c A C D F 1 − s/c 1 + s/c A C |µfi|2 6ε0$2 T/3 T 3T Frequency Absorptionintensity Fig. 13.7 The Gaussian shape of a Dopplerbroadened spectral line reflects the Maxwell distribution of speeds in the sample at the temperature of the experiment. Notice that the line broadens as the temperature is increased. Exploration In a spectrometer that makes use of phase-sensitive detection the output signal is proportional to the first derivative of the signal intensity, dI/dν. Plot the resulting line shape for various temperatures. How is the separation of the peaks related to the temperature? 13.3 LINEWIDTHS 437 Justification that, when the temperature is T and the mass of the molecule is m, then the observed width of the line at half-height (in terms of frequency or wavelength) is δνobs = 1/2 δλobs = 1/2 (13.17) For a molecule like N2 at room temperature (T ≈ 300 K), δν/ν ≈ 2.3 × 10−6 . For a typical rotational transition wavenumber of 1 cm−1 (corresponding to a frequency of 30 GHz), the linewidth is about 70 kHz. Doppler broadening increases with temperature because the molecules acquire a wider range of speeds. Therefore, to obtain spectra of maximum sharpness, it is best to work with cold samples. A note on good practice You will often hear people speak of ‘a frequency as so many wavenumbers’. This usage is doubly wrong. First, frequency and wavenumber are two distinct physical observables with different units, and should be distinguished. Second, ‘wavenumber’ is not a unit, it is an observable with the dimensions of 1/length and commonly reported in reciprocal centimetres (cm−1 ). Justification 13.3 Doppler broadening We know from the Boltzmann distribution (Molecular interpretation 3.1) that the probability that a gas molecule of mass m and speed s in a sample with temperature T has kinetic energy EK = 1 –2 ms2 is proportional to e−ms2 /2kT . The observed frequencies, νobs, emitted or absorbed by the molecule are related to its speed by eqn 13.16: νobs = ν where ν is the unshifted frequency. When s << c, the Doppler shift in the frequency is νobs − ν ≈ ±νs/c which implies a symmetrical distribution of observed frequencies with respect to molecular speeds. More specifically, the intensity I of a transition at νobs is proportional to the probability of finding the molecule that emits or absorbs at νobs, so it follows from the Boltzmannmdistribution and the expression for the Doppler shift that I(νobs) ∝ e−mc2 (νobs−ν)2 /2ν2 kT which has the form of a Gaussian function. The width at half-height can be calculated directly from the exponent (see Comment 13.3) to give eqn 13.17. (b) Lifetime broadening It is found that spectroscopic lines from gas-phase samples are not infinitely sharp even when Doppler broadening has been largely eliminated by working at low temperatures. The same is true of the spectra of samples in condensed phases and solution. This residual broadening is due to quantum mechanical effects. Specifically, when the Schrödinger equation is solved for a system that is changing with time, it is found that it is impossible to specify the energy levels exactly. If on average a system survives in a state for a time τ (tau), the lifetime of the state, then its energy levels are blurred to an extent of order δE, where D E F 1 1 ± s/c A B C D F 2kT ln 2 m A C 2λ c D F 2kT ln 2 m A C 2ν c Comment 13.3 A Gaussian function of the general form y(x) = ae−(x−b)2 /2σ2 , where a, b, and σ are constants, has a maximum y(b) = a and a width at half-height δx = 2σ(2 ln 2)1/2 . 438 13 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 1: ROTATIONAL AND VIBRATIONAL SPECTRA δE ≈ (13.18) This expression is reminiscent of the Heisenberg uncertainty principle (eqn 8.40), and consequently this lifetimebroadening is often called ‘uncertainty broadening’. When the energy spread is expressed as a wavenumber through δE = hcδ#, and the values of the fundamental constants introduced, this relation becomes δ# ≈ (13.19) No excited state has an infinite lifetime; therefore, all states are subject to some lifetime broadening and, the shorter the lifetimes of the states involved in a transition, the broader the corresponding spectral lines. Two processes are responsible for the finite lifetimes of excited states. The dominant one for low frequency transitions is collisional deactivation, which arises from collisions between molecules or with the walls of the container. If the collisional lifetime, the mean time between collisions, is τcol, the resulting collisional linewidth is δEcol ≈ $/τcol. Because τcol = 1/z, where z is the collision frequency, and from the kinetic model of gases (Section 1.3) we know that z is proportional to the pressure, we see that the collisional linewidth is proportional to the pressure. The collisional linewidth can therefore be minimized by working at low pressures. The rate of spontaneous emission cannot be changed. Hence it is a natural limit to the lifetime of an excited state, and the resulting lifetime broadening is the natural linewidth of the transition. The natural linewidth is an intrinsic property of the transition, and cannot be changed by modifying the conditions. Natural linewidths depend strongly on the transition frequency (they increase with the coefficient of spontaneous emission A and therefore as ν3 ), so low frequency transitions (such as the microwave transitions of rotational spectroscopy) have very small natural linewidths, and collisional and Doppler line-broadening processes are dominant. The natural lifetimes of electronic transitions are very much shorter than for vibrational and rotational transitions, so the natural linewidths of electronic transitions are much greater than those of vibrational and rotational transitions. For example, a typical electronic excited state natural lifetime is about 10−8 s (10 ns), corresponding to a natural width of about 5 × 10−4 cm−1 (15 MHz). A typical rotational state natural lifetime is about 103 s,correspondingtoanaturallinewidthofonly5 ×10−15 cm−1 (oftheorderof10−4 Hz). IMPACT ON ASTROPHYSICS I13.1 Rotational and vibrational spectroscopy of interstellar space Observations by the Cosmic Background Explorer (COBE) satellite support the long-held hypothesis that the distribution of energy in the current Universe can be modelled by a Planck distribution (eqn. 8.5) with T = 2.726 ± 0.001 K, the bulk of the radiation spanning the microwave region of the spectrum. This cosmic microwave background radiation is the residue of energy released during the Big Bang, the event that brought the Universe into existence. Very small fluctuations in the background temperature are believed to account for the large-scale structure of the Universe. The interstellar space in our galaxy is a little warmer than the cosmic background and consists largely of dust grains and gas clouds. The dust grains are carbon-based compounds and silicates of aluminium, magnesium, and iron, in which are embedded trace amounts of methane, water, and ammonia. Interstellar clouds are significant because it is from them that new stars, and consequently new planets, are formed. The hottest clouds are plasmas with temperatures of up to 106 K and densities of only about 3 × 103 particles m−3 . Colder clouds range from 0.1 to 1000 solar masses (1 solar 5.3 cm−1 τ/ps $ τ I13.1 IMPACT ON ASTROPHYSICS: ROTATIONAL AND VIBRATIONAL SPECTROSCOPY OF INTERSTELLAR SPACE 439 mass = 2 × 1030 kg), have a density of about 5 × 105 particles m−3 , consist largely of hydrogen atoms, and have a temperature of about 80 K. There are also colder and denser clouds, some with masses greater than 500 000 solar masses, densities greater than 109 particles m−3 , and temperatures that can be lower than 10 K. They are also called molecular clouds, because they are composed primarily of H2 and CO gas in a proportion of about 105 to 1. There are also trace amounts of larger molecules. To place the densities in context, the density of liquid water at 298 K and 1 bar is about 3 × 1028 particles m−3 . It follows from the the Boltzmann distribution and the low temperature of a molecular cloud that the vast majority of a cloud’s molecules are in their vibrational and electronic ground states. However, rotational excited states are populated at 10–100 K and decay by spontaneous emission. As a result, the spectrum of the cloud in the radiofrequency and microwave regions consists of sharp lines corresponding to rotational transitions (Fig. 13.8). The emitted light is collected by Earth-bound or spaceborne radiotelescopes, telescopes with antennas and detectors optimized for the collection and analysis of radiation in the microwave–radiowave range of the spectrum. Earth-bound radiotelescopes are often located at the tops of high mountains, as atmospheric water vapour can reabsorb microwave radiation from space and hence interfere with the measurement. Over 100 interstellar molecules have been identified by their rotational spectra, often by comparing radiotelescope data with spectra obtained in the laboratory or calculated by computational methods. The experiments have revealed the presence of trace amounts (with abundances of less than 10−8 relative to hydrogen) of neutral molecules, ions, and radicals. Examples of neutral molecules include hydrides, oxides (including water), sulfides, halogenated compounds, nitriles, hydrocarbons, aldehydes, alcohols, ethers, ketones, and amides. The largest molecule detected by rotational spectroscopy is the nitrile HC11N. Interstellar space can also be investigated with vibrational spectroscopy by using a combination of telescopes and infrared detectors. The experiments are conducted Fig. 13.8 Rotational spectrum of the Orion nebula, showing spectral fingerprints of diatomic and polyatomic molecules present in the interstellar cloud. Adapted from G.A. Blake et al., Astrophys. J. 315, 621 (1987). 440 13 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 1: ROTATIONAL AND VIBRATIONAL SPECTRA R mA mB R¢ mA mB mC R mA mB R R mA mC mB mA mA mA R R¢ q mB mC mC mA mA mA mA R R¢ mB mA mA mA R q mB mA mA mA R mA mB mA mA mA mA R mA mA Table 13.1 Moments of inertia* 1. Diatomic molecules I = µR2 µ = 2. Triatomic linear rotors I = mAR2 + mCR′2 − I = 2mAR2 3. Symmetric rotors I|| = 2mA(1 − cosθ)R2 I⊥ = mA(1 − cosθ)R2 + (mB + mC)(1 + 2cosθ)R2 + {(3mA + mB)R′+ 6mAR[1 –3(1 + 2cosθ)]1/2 }R′ I|| = 2mA(1 − cosθ)R2 I⊥ = mA(1 − cosθ)R2 + (1 + 2cosθ)R2 I|| = 4mAR2 I⊥ = 2mAR2 + 2mCR′2 4. Spherical rotors I = 8 –3mAR2 I = 4mAR2 * In each case, m is the total mass of the molecule. mAmB m mC m mA m (mAR − mCR′)2 m mAmB m 13.4 MOMENTS OF INERTIA 441 mC mD mD mD rD mA mA mA mB rA I m r m r= 3 + 3A A D D 2 2 Fig. 13.9 The definition of moment of inertia. In this molecule there are three identical atoms attached to the B atom and three different but mutually identical atoms attached to the C atom. In this example, the centre of mass lies on an axis passing through the B and C atom, and the perpendicular distances are measured from this axis. Ia Ib Ic Fig. 13.10 An asymmetric rotor has three different moments of inertia; all three rotation axes coincide at the centre of mass of the molecule. rH R f 1 C2 primarily in space-borne telescopes because the Earth’s atmosphere absorbs a great deal of infrared radiation (see Impact I13.2). In most cases, absorption by an interstellar species is detected against the background of infrared radiation emitted by a nearby star. The data can detect the presence of gas and solid water, CO, and CO2 in molecular clouds. In certain cases, infrared emission can be detected, but these events are rare because interstellar space is too cold and does not provide enough energy to promote a significant number of molecules to vibrational excited states. However, infrared emissions can be observed if molecules are occasionally excited by highenergy photons emitted by hot stars in the vicinity of the cloud. For example, the polycyclic aromatic hydrocarbons hexabenzocoronene (C48H24) and circumcoronene (C54H18) have been identified from characteristic infrared emissions. Pure rotation spectra The general strategy we adopt for discussing molecular spectra and the information they contain is to find expressions for the energy levels of molecules and then to calculate the transition frequencies by applying the selection rules. We then predict the appearance of the spectrum by taking into account the transition moments and the populations of the states. In this section we illustrate the strategy by considering the rotational states of molecules. 13.4 Moments of inertia The key molecular parameter we shall need is the moment of inertia, I, of the molecule (Section 9.6). The moment of inertia of a molecule is defined as the mass of each atom multiplied by the square of its distance from the rotational axis through the centre of mass of the molecule (Fig. 13.9): I = ∑ i miri 2 [13.20] where ri is the perpendicular distance of the atom i from the axis of rotation. The moment of inertia depends on the masses of the atoms present and the molecular geometry, so we can suspect (and later shall see explicitly) that rotational spectroscopy will give information about bond lengths and bond angles. In general, the rotational properties of any molecule can be expressed in terms of the moments of inertia about three perpendicular axes set in the molecule (Fig. 13.10). The convention is to label the moments of inertia Ia, Ib, and Ic, with the axes chosen so that Ic ≥ Ib ≥ Ia. For linear molecules, the moment of inertia around the internuclear axis is zero. The explicit expressions for the moments of inertia of some symmetrical molecules are given in Table 13.1. Example 13.1 Calculating the moment of inertia of a molecule Calculate the moment of inertia of an H2O molecule around the axis defined by the bisector of the HOH angle (1). The HOH bond angle is 104.5° and the bond length is 95.7 pm. Method According to eqn 13.20, the moment of inertia is the sum of the masses multiplied by the squares of their distances from the axis of rotation. The latter can be expressed by using trigonometry and the bond angle and bond length. 442 13 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 1: ROTATIONAL AND VIBRATIONAL SPECTRA I I I II Ia Ic Ib 0 Linear Spherical rotor Symmetric rotor I I I Asymmetric rotor Fig. 13.11 A schematic illustration of the classification of rigid rotors. Answer From eqn 13.20, I = ∑ i mir2 i = mHr2 H + 0 + mHr2 H = 2mHr2 H If the bond angle of the molecule is denoted 2φ and the bond length is R, trigonometry gives rH = R sin φ. It follows that I = 2mHR2 sin2 φ Substitution of the data gives I = 2 × (1.67 × 10−27 kg) × (9.57 × 10−11 m)2 × sin2 52.3° = 1.91 × 10−47 kg m2 Note that the mass of the O atom makes no contribution to the moment of inertia for this mode of rotation as the atom is immobile while the H atoms circulate around it. A note on good practice The mass to use in the calculation of the moment of inertia is the actual atomic mass, not the element’s molar mass; don’t forget to convert from atomic mass units (u, formerly amu) to kilograms. Self-test 13.1 Calculate the moment of inertia of a CH35 Cl3 molecule around a rotational axis that contains the C-H bond. The C-Cl bond length is 177 pm and the HCCl angle is 107°; m(35 Cl) = 34.97 u. [4.99 × 10−45 kg m2 ] We shall suppose initially that molecules are rigid rotors, bodies that do not distort under the stress of rotation. Rigid rotors can be classified into four types (Fig. 13.11): Spherical rotors have three equal moments of inertia (examples: CH4, SiH4, and SF6). Symmetric rotors have two equal moments of inertia (examples: NH3, CH3Cl, and CH3CN). Linear rotors have one moment of inertia (the one about the molecular axis) equal to zero (examples: CO2, HCl, OCS, and HC.CH). Asymmetric rotors have three different moments of inertia (examples: H2O, H2CO, and CH3OH). 13.5 THE ROTATIONAL ENERGY LEVELS 443 13.5 The rotational energy levels The rotational energy levels of a rigid rotor may be obtained by solving the appropriate Schrödinger equation. Fortunately, however, there is a much less onerous short cut to the exact expressions that depends on noting the classical expression for the energy of a rotating body, expressing it in terms of the angular momentum, and then importing the quantum mechanical properties of angular momentum into the equations. The classical expression for the energy of a body rotating about an axis a is Ea = 1 –2Iaωa 2 (13.21) where ωa is the angular velocity (in radians per second, rad s−1 ) about that axis and Ia is the corresponding moment of inertia. A body free to rotate about three axes has an energy E = 1 –2Iaωa 2 + 1 –2Ibωb 2 + 1 –2Icωc 2 Because the classical angular momentum about the axis a is Ja = Iaωa, with similar expressions for the other axes, it follows that E = + + (13.22) This is the key equation. We described the quantum mechanical properties of angular momentum in Section 9.7b, and can now make use of them in conjunction with this equation to obtain the rotational energy levels. (a) Spherical rotors When all three moments of inertia are equal to some value I, as in CH4 and SF6, the classical expression for the energy is E = = where J2 = Ja 2 + Jb 2 + Jc 2 is the square of the magnitude of the angular momentum. We can immediately find the quantum expression by making the replacement J2 → J(J + 1)$2 J = 0, 1, 2, . . . Therefore, the energy of a spherical rotor is confined to the values EJ = J(J + 1) J = 0, 1, 2, . . . (13.23) The resulting ladder of energy levels is illustrated in Fig. 13.12. The energy is normally expressed in terms of the rotational constant, B, of the molecule, where hcB = so B = [13.24] The expression for the energy is then EJ = hcBJ(J + 1) J = 0, 1, 2, . . . (13.25) The rotational constant as defined by eqn 13.25 is a wavenumber. The energy of a rotational state is normally reported as the rotational term, F(J), a wavenumber, by division by hc: F(J) = BJ(J + 1) (13.26) $ 4πcI $2 2I $2 2I J2 2I Ja 2 + Jb 2 + Jc 2 2I Jc 2 2Ic Jb 2 2Ib Ja 2 2Ia 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 0 Energy J 2B 4B 6B 8B 0 1 2 3 Fig. 13.12 The rotational energy levels of a linear or spherical rotor. Note that the energy separation between neighbouring levels increases as J increases. Comment 13.4 The definition of B as a wavenumber is convenient when we come to vibration–rotation spectra. However, for pure rotational spectroscopy it is more common to define B as a frequency. Then B = $/4πcI and the energy is E = hBJ(J + 1). 444 13 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 1: ROTATIONAL AND VIBRATIONAL SPECTRA K = 0 K J» J J (a) (b) Fig. 13.13 The significance of the quantum number K. (a) When |K| is close to its maximum value, J, most of the molecular rotation is around the figure axis. (b) When K = 0 the molecule has no angular momentum about its principal axis: it is undergoing end-over-end rotation. The separation of adjacent levels is F(J) − F(J − 1) = 2BJ (13.27) Because the rotational constant decreases as I increases, we see that large molecules have closely spaced rotational energy levels. We can estimate the magnitude of the separation by considering CCl4: from the bond lengths and masses of the atoms we find I = 4.85 × 10−45 kg m2 , and hence B = 0.0577 cm−1 . (b) Symmetric rotors In symmetric rotors, two moments of inertia are equal but different from the third (as in CH3Cl, NH3, and C6H6); the unique axis of the molecule is its principal axis (or figure axis). We shall write the unique moment of inertia (that about the principal axis) as I|| and the other two as I⊥. If I|| > I⊥, the rotor is classified as oblate (like a pancake, and C6H6); if I|| < I⊥ it is classified as prolate (like a cigar, and CH3Cl). The classical expression for the energy, eqn 13.22, becomes E = + Again, this expression can be written in terms of J2 = Ja 2 + Jb 2 + Jc 2 : E = + = + − Ja 2 (13.28) Now we generate the quantum expression by replacing J2 by J(J + 1)$2 , where J is the angular momentum quantum number. We also know from the quantum theory of angular momentum (Section 9.7b) that the component of angular momentum about any axis is restricted to the values K$, with K = 0, ±1, . . . , ± J. (K is the quantum number used to signify a component on the principal axis; MJ is reserved for a component on an externally defined axis.) Therefore, we also replace Ja 2 by K2 $2 . It follows that the rotational terms are F(J,K) = BJ(J + 1) + (A − B)K2 J = 0, 1, 2, . . . K = 0, ±1, . . . , ± J (13.29) with A = B = [13.30] Equation 13.29 matches what we should expect for the dependence of the energy levels on the two distinct moments of inertia of the molecule. When K = 0, there is no component of angular momentum about the principal axis, and the energy levels depend only on I⊥ (Fig. 13.13). When K = ± J, almost all the angular momentum arises from rotation around the principal axis, and the energy levels are determined largely by I||. The sign of K does not affect the energy because opposite values of K correspond to opposite senses of rotation, and the energy does not depend on the sense of rotation. Example 13.2 Calculating the rotational energy levels of a molecule A 14 NH3 molecule is a symmetric rotor with bond length 101.2 pm and HNH bond angle 106.7°. Calculate its rotational terms. A note on good practice To calculate moments of inertia precisely, we need to specify the nuclide. $ 4πcI⊥ $ 4πcI|| D F 1 2I⊥ 1 2I|| A C J2 2I Ja 2 2I|| J2 − Ja 2 2I⊥ Ja 2 2I|| Jb 2 + Jc 2 2I| 13.5 THE ROTATIONAL ENERGY LEVELS 445 J MJ MJ = 0 z (a) (b) (c) Fig. 13.14 The significance of the quantum number MJ. (a) When MJ is close to its maximum value, J, most of the molecular rotation is around the laboratory z-axis. (b) An intermediate value of MJ. (c) When MJ = 0 the molecule has no angular momentum about the z-axis All three diagrams correspond to a state with K = 0; there are corresponding diagrams for different values of K, in which the angular momentum makes a different angle to the molecule’s principal axis. Method Begin by calculating the rotational constants A and B by using the expressions for moments of inertia given in Table 13.1. Then use eqn 13.29 to find the rotational terms. Answer Substitution of mA = 1.0078 u, mB = 14.0031 u, R = 101.2 pm, and θ = 106.7° into the second of the symmetric rotor expressions in Table 13.1 gives I|| = 4.4128 × 10−47 kg m2 and I⊥ = 2.8059 × 10−47 kg m2 . Hence, A = 6.344 cm−1 and B = 9.977 cm−1 . It follows from eqn 13.29 that F(J,K)/cm−1 = 9.977J(J + 1) − 3.633K2 Upon multiplication by c, F(J,K) acquires units of frequency: F(J,K)/GHz = 299.1J(J + 1) − 108.9K2 For J = 1, the energy needed for the molecule to rotate mainly about its figure axis (K = ±J) is equivalent to 16.32 cm−1 (489.3 GHz), but end-over-end rotation (K = 0) corresponds to 19.95 cm−1 (598.1 GHz). Self-test 13.2 A CH3 35 Cl molecule has a C-Cl bond length of 178 pm, a C-H bond length of 111 pm, and an HCH angle of 110.5°. Calculate its rotational energy terms. [F(J,K)/cm−1 = 0.444J(J + 1) + 4.58K2 ; also F(J,K)/GHz = 13.3J(J + 1) + 137K2 ] (c) Linear rotors For a linear rotor (such as CO2, HCl, and C2H2), in which the nuclei are regarded as mass points, the rotation occurs only about an axis perpendicular to the line of atoms and there is zero angular momentum around the line. Therefore, the component of angular momentum around the figure axis of a linear rotor is identically zero, and K . 0 in eqn 13.29. The rotational terms of a linear molecule are therefore F(J) = BJ(J + 1) J = 0, 1, 2, . . . (13.31) This expression is the same as eqn 13.26 but we have arrived at it in a significantly different way: here K . 0 but for a spherical rotor A = B. (d) Degeneracies and the Stark effect The energy of a symmetric rotor depends on J and K, and each level except those with K = 0 is doubly degenerate: the states with K and −K have the same energy. However, we must not forget that the angular momentum of the molecule has a component on an external, laboratory-fixed axis. This component is quantized, and its permitted values are MJ$, with MJ = 0, ±1, . . . , ±J, giving 2J + 1 values in all (Fig. 13.14). The quantum number MJ does not appear in the expression for the energy, but it is necessary for a complete specification of the state of the rotor. Consequently, all 2J + 1 orientations of the rotating molecule have the same energy. It follows that a symmetric rotor level is 2(2J + 1)-fold degenerate for K ≠ 0 and (2J + 1)-fold degenerate for K = 0. A linear rotor has K fixed at 0, but the angular momentum may still have 2J + 1 components on the laboratory axis, so its degeneracy is 2J + 1. A spherical rotor can be regarded as a version of a symmetric rotor in which A is equal to B: The quantum number K may still take any one of 2J + 1 values, but the energy is independent of which value it takes. Therefore, as well as having a (2J + 1)fold degeneracy arising from its orientation in space, the rotor also has a (2J + 1)-fold degeneracy arising from its orientation with respect to an arbitrary axis in the 446 13 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 1: ROTATIONAL AND VIBRATIONAL SPECTRA molecule. The overall degeneracy of a symmetric rotor with quantum number J is therefore (2J + 1)2 . This degeneracy increases very rapidly: when J = 10, for instance, there are 441 states of the same energy. The degeneracy associated with the quantum number MJ (the orientation of the rotation in space) is partly removed when an electric field is applied to a polar molecule (e.g. HCl or NH3), as illustrated in Fig. 13.15. The splitting of states by an electric field is called the Stark effect. For a linear rotor in an electric field E, the energy of the state with quantum numbers J and M-J is given by E(J,MJ) = hcBJ(J + 1) + a(J,MJ)µ2 E2 (13.32a) where (see Further reading for a derivation) a(J,MJ) = (13.32b) Note that the energy of a state with quantum number MJ depends on the square of the permanent electric dipole moment, µ. The observation of the Stark effect can therefore be used to measure this property, but the technique is limited to molecules that are sufficiently volatile to be studied by rotational spectroscopy. However, as spectra can be recorded for samples at pressures of only about 1 Pa and special techniques (such as using an intense laser beam or an electrical discharge) can be used to vaporize even some quite nonvolatile substances, a wide variety of samples may be studied. Sodium chloride, for example, can be studied as diatomic NaCl molecules at high temperatures. (e) Centrifugal distortion We have treated molecules as rigid rotors. However, the atoms of rotating molecules are subject to centrifugal forces that tend to distort the molecular geometry and change the moments of inertia (Fig. 13.16). The effect of centrifugal distortion on a diatomic molecule is to stretch the bond and hence to increase the moment of inertia. As a result, centrifugal distortion reduces the rotational constant and consequently the energy levels are slightly closer than the rigid-rotor expressions predict. The effect is usually taken into account largely empirically by subtracting a term from the energy and writing F(J) = BJ(J + 1) − DJJ2 (J + 1)2 (13.33) The parameter DJ is the centrifugal distortion constant. It is large when the bond is easily stretched. The centrifugal distortion constant of a diatomic molecule is related to the vibrational wavenumber of the bond, # (which, as we shall see later, is a measure of its stiffness), through the approximate relation (see Problem 13.22) DJ = (13.34) Hence the observation of the convergence of the rotational levels as J increases can be interpreted in terms of the rigidity of the bond. 13.6 Rotational transitions Typical values of B for small molecules are in the region of 0.1 to10 cm−1 (for example, 0.356 cm−1 for NF3 and 10.59 cm−1 for HCl), so rotational transitions lie in the microwave region of the spectrum. The transitions are detected by monitoring the net absorption of microwave radiation. Modulation of the transmitted intensity can be achieved by varying the energy levels with an oscillating electric field. In this Stark 4B3 #2 J(J + 1) − 3M2 J 2hcBJ(J + 1)(2J − 1)(2J + 3) 0 ±1 ±2 ±3 ±4 ±5 ±6 ±7 MJ Field on Field off Fig. 13.15 The effect of an electric field on the energy levels of a polar linear rotor. All levels are doubly degenerate except that with MJ = 0. Centrifugal force Fig. 13.16 The effect of rotation on a molecule. The centrifugal force arising from rotation distorts the molecule, opening out bond angles and stretching bonds slightly. The effect is to increase the moment of inertia of the molecule and hence to decrease its rotational constant. 13.6 ROTATIONAL TRANSITIONS 447 m m Fig. 13.17 To a stationary observer, a rotating polar molecule looks like an oscillating dipole that can stir the electromagnetic field into oscillation (and vice versa for absorption). This picture is the classical origin of the gross selection rule for rotational transitions. hn Fig. 13.18 When a photon is absorbed by a molecule, the angular momentum of the combined system is conserved. If the molecule is rotating in the same sense as the spin of the incoming photon, then J increases by 1. modulation, an electric field of about 105 V m−1 and a frequency of between 10 and 100 kHz is applied to the sample. (a) Rotational selection rules We have already remarked (Section 13.2) that the gross selection rule for the observation of a pure rotational spectrum is that a molecule must have a permanent electric dipole moment. That is, for a molecule to give a pure rotational spectrum, it must be polar. The classical basis of this rule is that a polar molecule appears to possess a fluctuating dipole when rotating, but a nonpolar molecule does not (Fig.13.17). The permanent dipole can be regarded as a handle with which the molecule stirs the electromagnetic field into oscillation (and vice versa for absorption). Homonuclear diatomic molecules and symmetrical linear molecules such as CO2 are rotationally inactive. Spherical rotors cannot have electric dipole moments unless they become distorted by rotation, so they are also inactive except in special cases. An example of a spherical rotor that does become sufficiently distorted for it to acquire a dipole moment is SiH4, which has a dipole moment of about 8.3 µD by virtue of its rotation when J ≈ 10 (for comparison, HCl has a permanent dipole moment of 1.1 D; molecular dipole moments and their units are discussed in Section 18.1). The pure rotational spectrum of SiH4 has been detected by using long path lengths (10 m) through highpressure (4 atm) samples. Illustration 13.2 Identifying rotationally active molecules Of the molecules N2, CO2, OCS, H2O, CH2=CH2, C6H6, only OCS and H2O are polar, so only these two molecules have microwave spectra. Self-test 13.3 Which of the molecules H2, NO, N2O, CH4 can have a pure rotational spectrum? [NO, N2O] The specific rotational selection rules are found by evaluating the transition dipole moment between rotational states. We show in Further information 13.2 that, for a linear molecule, the transition moment vanishes unless the following conditions are fulfilled: ∆J = ±1 ∆MJ = 0, ±1 (13.35) The transition ∆J = +1 corresponds to absorption and the transition ∆J = −1 corresponds to emission. The allowed change in J in each case arises from the conservation of angular momentum when a photon, a spin-1 particle, is emitted or absorbed (Fig. 13.18). When the transition moment is evaluated for all possible relative orientations of the molecule to the line of flight of the photon, it is found that the total J + 1 ↔ J transition intensity is proportional to |µJ+1,J |2 = µ0 2 → 1 –2µ0 2 for J >> 1 (13.36) where µ0 is the permanent electric dipole moment of the molecule. The intensity is proportional to the square of the permanent electric dipole moment, so strongly polar molecules give rise to much more intense rotational lines than less polar molecules. For symmetric rotors, an additional selection rule states that ∆K = 0. To understand this rule, consider the symmetric rotor NH3, where the electric dipole moment lies D F J + 1 2J + 1 A C 448 13 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 1: ROTATIONAL AND VIBRATIONAL SPECTRA Energy Frequency Transmission Fig. 13.19 The rotational energy levels of a linear rotor, the transitions allowed by the selection rule ∆J = ±1, and a typical pure rotational absorption spectrum (displayed here in terms of the radiation transmitted through the sample). The intensities reflect the populations of the initial level in each case and the strengths of the transition dipole moments. parallel to the figure axis. Such a molecule cannot be accelerated into different states of rotation around the figure axis by the absorption of radiation, so ∆K = 0. (b) The appearance of rotational spectra When these selection rules are applied to the expressions for the energy levels of a rigid symmetric or linear rotor, it follows that the wavenumbers of the allowed J + 1 ← J absorptions are #(J + 1 ← J) = 2B(J + 1) J = 0, 1, 2, . . . (13.37) When centrifugal distortion is taken into account, the corresponding expression is #(J + 1 ← J) = 2B(J + 1) − 4DJ(J + 1)3 (13.38) However, because the second term is typically very small compared with the first, the appearance of the spectrum closely resembles that predicted from eqn 13.37. Example 13.3 Predicting the appearance of a rotational spectrum Predict the form of the rotational spectrum of 14 NH3. Method We calculated the energy levels in Example 13.2. The 14 NH3 molecule is a polar symmetric rotor, so the selection rules ∆J = ±1 and ∆K = 0 apply. For absorption, ∆J = +1 and we can use eqn 13.37. Because B = 9.977 cm−1 , we can draw up the following table for the J + 1 ← J transitions. J 0 1 2 3 . . . #/cm−1 19.95 39.91 59.86 79.82 . . . ν/GHz 598.1 1197 1795 2393 . . . The line spacing is 19.95 cm−1 (598.1 GHz). Self-test 13.4 Repeat the problem for C35 ClH3 (see Self-test 13.2 for details). [Lines of separation 0.888 cm−1 (26.6 GHz)] The form of the spectrum predicted by eqn 13.37 is shown in Fig. 13.19. The most significant feature is that it consists of a series of lines with wavenumbers 2B, 4B, 6B, . . . and of separation 2B. The measurement of the line spacing gives B, and hence the moment of inertia perpendicular to the principal axis of the molecule. Because the masses of the atoms are known, it is a simple matter to deduce the bond length of a diatomic molecule. However, in the case of a polyatomic molecule such as OCS or NH3, the analysis gives only a single quantity, I⊥, and it is not possible to infer both bond lengths (in OCS) or the bond length and bond angle (in NH3). This difficulty can be overcome by using isotopically substituted molecules, such as ABC and A′BC; then, by assuming that R(A-B) = R(A′-B), both A-B and B-C bond lengths can be extracted from the two moments of inertia. A famous example of this procedure is the study of OCS; the actual calculation is worked through in Problem 13.10. The assumption that bond lengths are unchanged by isotopic substitution is only an approximation, but it is a good approximation in most cases. The intensities of spectral lines increase with increasing J and pass through a maximum before tailing off as J becomes large. The most important reason for the maximum in intensity is the existence of a maximum in the population of rotational levels. The Boltzmann distribution (Molecular interpretation 3.1) implies that the population of each state decays exponentially with increasing J, but the degeneracy of the levels 13.7 ROTATIONAL RAMAN SPECTRA 449 increases. Specifically, the population of a rotational energy level J is given by the Boltzmann expression NJ ∝ NgJe−EJ/kT where N is the total number of molecules and gJ is the degeneracy of the level J. The value of J corresponding to a maximum of this expression is found by treating J as a continuous variable, differentiating with respect to J, and then setting the result equal to zero. The result is (see Problem 13.24) Jmax ≈ 1/2 − 1 –2 (13.39) For a typical molecule (for example, OCS, with B = 0.2 cm−1 ) at room temperature, kT ≈ 1000hcB, so Jmax ≈ 30. However, it must be recalled that the intensity of each transition also depends on the value of J (eqn 13.36) and on the population difference between the two states involved in the transition (see Section 13.2). Hence the value of J corresponding to the most intense line is not quite the same as the value of J for the most highly populated level. 13.7 Rotational Raman spectra The gross selection rule for rotational Raman transitions is that the molecule must be anisotropically polarizable. We begin by explaining what this means. A formal derivation of this rule is given in Further information 13.2. The distortion of a molecule in an electric field is determined by its polarizability, α (Section 18.2). More precisely, if the strength of the field is E, then the molecule acquires an induced dipole moment of magnitude µ = αE (13.40) in addition to any permanent dipole moment it may have. An atom is isotropically polarizable. That is, the same distortion is induced whatever the direction of the applied field. The polarizability of a spherical rotor is also isotropic. However, nonspherical rotors have polarizabilities that do depend on the direction of the field relative to the molecule, so these molecules are anisotropically polarizable (Fig. 13.20). The electron distribution in H2, for example, is more distorted when the field is applied parallel to the bond than when it is applied perpendicular to it, and we write α|| > α⊥. All linear molecules and diatomics (whether homonuclear or heteronuclear) have anisotropic polarizabilities, and so are rotationally Raman active. This activity is one reason for the importance of rotational Raman spectroscopy, for the technique can be used to study many of the molecules that are inaccessible to microwave spectroscopy. Spherical rotors such as CH4 and SF6, however, are rotationally Raman inactive as well as microwave inactive. This inactivity does not mean that such molecules are never found in rotationally excited states. Molecular collisions do not have to obey such restrictive selection rules, and hence collisions between molecules can result in the population of any rotational state. We show in Further information 13.2 that the specific rotational Raman selection rules are Linear rotors: ∆J = 0, ±2 (13.41) Symmetric rotors: ∆J = 0, ±1, ±2; ∆K = 0 The ∆J = 0 transitions do not lead to a shift of the scattered photon’s frequency in pure rotational Raman spectroscopy, and contribute to the unshifted Rayleigh radiation. D F kT 2hcB A C E E (a) (b) Distortion Fig. 13.20 An electric field applied to a molecule results in its distortion, and the distorted molecule acquires a contribution to its dipole moment (even if it is nonpolar initially). The polarizability may be different when the field is applied (a) parallel or (b) perpendicular to the molecular axis (or, in general, in different directions relative to the molecule); if that is so, then the molecule has an anisotropic polarizability. 450 13 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 1: ROTATIONAL AND VIBRATIONAL SPECTRA Energy Stokes lines Anti-Stokes lines Rayleighline Frequency Fig. 13.21 The rotational energy levels of a linear rotor and the transitions allowed by the ∆J = ± 2 Raman selection rules. The form of a typical rotational Raman spectrum is also shown. The Rayleigh line is much stronger than depicted in the figure; it is shown as a weaker line to improve visualization of the Raman lines. We can predict the form of the Raman spectrum of a linear rotor by applying the selection rule ∆J = ±2 to the rotational energy levels (Fig. 13.21). When the molecule makes a transition with ∆J = +2, the scattered radiation leaves the molecule in a higher rotational state, so the wavenumber of the incident radiation, initially #i, is decreased. These transitions account for the Stokes lines in the spectrum: #(J + 2 ← J) = #i − {F(J + 2) − F(J)} = #i − 2B(2J + 3) (13.42a) The Stokes lines appear to low frequency of the incident radiation and at displacements 6B, 10B, 14B, . . . from #i for J = 0, 1, 2, . . . . When the molecule makes a transition with ∆J = −2, the scattered photon emerges with increased energy. These transitions account for the anti-Stokes lines of the spectrum: #(J − 2 ← J) = #i + {F(J) − F(J − 2)} = #i + 2B(2J − 1) (13.42b) The anti-Stokes lines occur at displacements of 6B, 10B, 14B, . . . (for J = 2, 3, 4, . . . ; J = 2 is the lowest state that can contribute under the selection rule ∆J = −2) to high frequency of the incident radiation. The separation of adjacent lines in both the Stokes and the anti-Stokes regions is 4B, so from its measurement I⊥ can be determined and then used to find the bond lengths exactly as in the case of microwave spectroscopy. Example 13.4 Predicting the form of a Raman spectrum Predict the form of the rotational Raman spectrum of 14 N2, for which B = 1.99 cm−1 , when it is exposed to monochromatic 336.732 nm laser radiation. Method The molecule is rotationally Raman active because end-over-end rotation modulates its polarizability as viewed by a stationary observer. The Stokes and anti-Stokes lines are given by eqn 13.42. Answer Because λi = 336.732 nm corresponds to #i = 29 697.2 cm−1 , eqns 13.42a and 13.42b give the following line positions: J 0 1 2 3 Stokes lines #/cm−1 29 685.3 29 677.3 29 669.3 29 661.4 λ/nm 336.868 336.958 337.048 337.139 Anti-Stokes lines #/cm−1 29 709.1 29 717.1 λ/nm 336.597 336.507 There will be a strong central line at 336.732 nm accompanied on either side by lines of increasing and then decreasing intensity (as a result of transition moment and population effects). The spread of the entire spectrum is very small, so the incident light must be highly monochromatic. Self-test 13.5 Repeat the calculation for the rotational Raman spectrum of NH3 (B = 9.977 cm−1 ). [Stokes lines at 29 637.3, 29 597.4, 29 557.5, 29 517.6 cm−1 , anti-Stokes lines at 29 757.1, 29 797.0 cm−1 .] 13.8 Nuclear statistics and rotational states If eqn 13.42 is used in conjunction with the rotational Raman spectrum of CO2, the rotational constant is inconsistent with other measurements of C-O bond lengths. 13.8 NUCLEAR STATISTICS AND ROTATIONAL STATES 451 The results are consistent only if it is supposed that the molecule can exist in states with even values of J, so the Stokes lines are 2 ← 0, 4 ← 2, . . . and not 2 ← 0, 3 ← 1, . . . . The explanation of the missing lines is the Pauli principle and the fact that O nuclei are spin-0 bosons: just as the Pauli principle excludes certain electronic states, so too does it exclude certain molecular rotational states. The form of the Pauli principle given in Justification Section 10.4 states that, when two identical bosons are exchanged, the overall wavefunction must remain unchanged in every respect, including sign. In particular, when a CO2 molecule rotates through 180°, two identical O nuclei are interchanged, so the overall wavefunction of the molecule must remain unchanged. However, inspection of the form of the rotational wavefunctions (which have the same form as the s, p, etc. orbitals of atoms) shows that they change sign by (−1)J under such a rotation (Fig. 13.22). Therefore, only even values of J are permissible for CO2, and hence the Raman spectrum shows only alternate lines. The selective occupation of rotational states that stems from the Pauli principle is termed nuclear statistics. Nuclear statistics must be taken into account whenever a rotation interchanges equivalent nuclei. However, the consequences are not always as simple as for CO2 because there are complicating features when the nuclei have nonzero spin: there may be several different relative nuclear spin orientations consistent with even values of J and a different number of spin orientations consistent with odd values of J. For molecular hydrogen and fluorine, for instance, with their two identical spin- 1 –2 nuclei, we show in the Justification below that there are three times as many ways of achieving a state with odd J than with even J, and there is a corresponding 3:1 alternation in intensity in their rotational Raman spectra (Fig. 13.23). In general, for a homonuclear diatomic molecule with nuclei of spin I, the numbers of ways of achieving states of odd and even J are in the ratio = (13.43) For hydrogen, I = 1 –2, and the ratio is 3:1. For N2, with I = 1, the ratio is 1:2. Justification 13.4 The effect of nuclear statistics on rotational spectra Hydrogen nuclei are fermions, so the Pauli principle requires the overall wavefunction to change sign under particle interchange. However, the rotation of an H2 molecule through 180° has a more complicated effect than merely relabelling the nuclei, because it interchanges their spin states too if the nuclear spins are paired (↑↓) but not if they are parallel (↑↑). For the overall wavefunction of the molecule to change sign when the spins are parallel, the rotational wavefunction must change sign. Hence, only odd values of J are allowed. In contrast, if the nuclear spins are paired, their wavefunction is α(A)β(B) − α(B)β(A), which changes sign when α and β are exchanged in order to bring about a simple A ↔ B interchange overall (Fig. 13.24). Therefore, for the overall wavefunction to change sign in this case requires the rotational wavefunction not to change sign. Hence, only even values of J are allowed if the nuclear spins are paired. As there are three nuclear spin states with parallel spins (just like the triplet state of two parallel electrons, as in Fig. 10.24), but only one state with paired spins (the analogue of the singlet state of two electrons, see Fig. 10.18), it follows that the populations of the odd J and even J states should be in the ratio of 3:1, and hence the intensities of transitions originating in these levels will be in the same ratio. Different relative nuclear spin orientations change into one another only very slowly, so an H2 molecule with parallel nuclear spins remains distinct from one with (I + 1)/I for half-integral spin nuclei I/(I + 1) for integral spin nuclei 1 2 3 Number of ways of achieving odd J Number of ways of achieving even J J = 2 J = 1 J = 0 Fig. 13.22 The symmetries of rotational wavefunctions (shown here, for simplicity as a two-dimensional rotor) under a rotation through 180°. Wavefunctions with J even do not change sign; those with J odd do change sign. Frequency Fig. 13.23 The rotational Raman spectrum of a diatomic molecule with two identical spin-1 –2 nuclei shows an alternation in intensity as a result of nuclear statistics. The Rayleigh line is much stronger than depicted in the figure; it is shown as a weaker line to improve visualization of the Raman lines. 452 13 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 1: ROTATIONAL AND VIBRATIONAL SPECTRA paired nuclear spins for long periods. The two forms of hydrogen can be separated by physical techniques, and stored. The form with parallel nuclear spins is called ortho-hydrogen and the form with paired nuclear spins is called para-hydrogen. Because ortho-hydrogen cannot exist in a state with J = 0, it continues to rotate at very low temperatures and has an effective rotational zero-point energy (Fig. 13.25). This energy is of some concern to manufacturers of liquid hydrogen, for the slow conversion of ortho-hydrogen into para-hydrogen (which can exist with J = 0) as nuclear spins slowly realign releases rotational energy, which vaporizes the liquid. Techniques are used to accelerate the conversion of ortho-hydrogen to para-hydrogen to avoid this problem. One such technique is to pass hydrogen over a metal surface: the molecules adsorb on the surface as atoms, which then recombine in the lower energy para-hydrogen form. The vibrations of diatomic molecules In this section, we adopt the same strategy of finding expressions for the energy levels, establishing the selection rules, and then discussing the form of the spectrum. We shall also see how the simultaneous excitation of rotation modifies the appearance of a vibrational spectrum. 13.9 Molecular vibrations We base our discussion on Fig. 13.26, which shows a typical potential energy curve (as in Fig. 11.1) of a diatomic molecule. In regions close to Re (at the minimum of the curve) the potential energy can be approximated by a parabola, so we can write V = 1 –2kx2 x = R − Re (13.44) where k is the force constant of the bond. The steeper the walls of the potential (the stiffer the bond), the greater the force constant. To see the connection between the shape of the molecular potential energy curve and the value of k, note that we can expand the potential energy around its minimum by using a Taylor series: V(x) =V(0) + 0 x + 1 –2 0 x2 + · · · (13.45) The term V(0) can be set arbitrarily to zero. The first derivative of V is 0 at the minimum. Therefore, the first surviving term is proportional to the square of the displacement. For small displacements we can ignore all the higher terms, and so write V(x) ≈ 1 –2 0 x2 (13.46) Therefore, the first approximation to a molecular potential energy curve is a parabolic potential, and we can identify the force constant as k = 0 [13.47] We see that if the potential energy curve is sharply curved close to its minimum, then k will be large. Conversely, if the potential energy curve is wide and shallow, then k will be small (Fig. 13.27). D F d2 V dx2 A C D F d2 V dx2 A C D F d2 V dx2 A C D F dV dx A C A A A B B B ( 1)- J Change sign if antiparallel Change sign Fig. 13.24 The interchange of two identical fermion nuclei results in the change in sign of the overall wavefunction. The relabelling can be thought of as occurring in two steps: the first is a rotation of the molecule; the second is the interchange of unlike spins (represented by the different colours of the nuclei). The wavefunction changes sign in the second step if the nuclei have antiparallel spins. J = 1 J = 0 Lowest rotational state of -hydrogenpara Lowest rotational state of -hydrogenortho Fig. 13.25 When hydrogen is cooled, the molecules with parallel nuclear spins accumulate in their lowest available rotational state, the one with J = 0. They can enter the lowest rotational state (J = 0) only if the spins change their relative orientation and become antiparallel. This is a slow process under normal circumstances, so energy is slowly released. 13.9 MOLECULAR VIBRATIONS 453 The Schrödinger equation for the relative motion of two atoms of masses m1 and m2 with a parabolic potential energy is − + 1 –2kx2 ψ = Eψ (13.48) where meff is the effective mass: meff = [13.49] These equations are derived in the same way as in Further information 10.1, but here the separation of variables procedure is used to separate the relative motion of the atoms from the motion of the molecule as a whole. In that context, the effective mass is called the ‘reduced mass’, and the name is widely used in this context too. The Schrödinger equation in eqn 13.48 is the same as eqn 9.24 for a particle of mass m undergoing harmonic motion. Therefore, we can use the results of Section 9.4 to write down the permitted vibrational energy levels: Ev = (v + 1 –2)$ω ω = 1/2 v = 0, 1, 2, . . . (13.50) The vibrational terms of a molecule, the energies of its vibrational states expressed in wavenumbers, are denoted G(v), with Ev = hcG(v), so G(v) = (v + 1 –2)# # = 1/2 (13.51) The vibrational wavefunctions are the same as those discussed in Section 9.5. It is important to note that the vibrational terms depend on the effective mass of the molecule, not directly on its total mass. This dependence is physically reasonable, for if atom 1 were as heavy as a brick wall, then we would find meff ≈ m2, the mass of the D F k meff A C 1 2πc D F k meff A C m1m2 m1 + m2 d2 ψ dx2 $2 2meff Parabola Molecularpotentialenergy Internuclear separation Re Fig. 13.26 A molecular potential energy curve can be approximated by a parabola near the bottom of the well. The parabolic potential leads to harmonic oscillations. At high excitation energies the parabolic approximation is poor (the true potential is less confining), and it is totally wrong near the dissociation limit. Comment 13.5 It is often useful to express a function f(x) in the vicinity of x = a as an infinite Taylor series of the form: f(x) = f(a) + a (x − a) + a (x − a)2 + · · · + a (x − a)n + · · · where n = 0, 1, 2, . . . . D E F dn f dxn A B C 1 n! D E F d2 f dx2 A B C 1 2! D E F df dx A B C k large k small Displacement, x 0 Potentialenergy,V Fig. 13.27 The force constant is a measure of the curvature of the potential energy close to the equilibrium extension of the bond. A strongly confining well (one with steep sides, a stiff bond) corresponds to high values of k. 454 13 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 1: ROTATIONAL AND VIBRATIONAL SPECTRA ¯ ¯ ¯ ¯ Fig. 13.28 The oscillation of a molecule, even if it is nonpolar, may result in an oscillating dipole that can interact with the electromagnetic field. lighter atom. The vibration would then be that of a light atom relative to that of a stationary wall (this is approximately the case in HI, for example, where the I atom barely moves and meff ≈ mH). For a homonuclear diatomic molecule m1 = m2, and the effective mass is half the total mass: meff = 1 –2m. Illustration 13.3 Calculating a vibrational wavenumber An HCl molecule has a force constant of 516 N m−1 , a reasonably typical value for a single bond. The effective mass of 1 H35 Cl is 1.63 × 10−27 kg (note that this mass is very close to the mass of the hydrogen atom, 1.67 × 10−27 kg, so the Cl atom is acting like a brick wall). These values imply ω = 5.63 × 1014 s−1 , ν = 89.5 THz (1 THz = 1012 Hz), # = 2990 cm−1 , λ = 3.35 µm. These characteristics correspond to electromagnetic radiation in the infrared region. 13.10 Selection rules The gross selection rule for a change in vibrational state brought about by absorption or emission of radiation is that the electric dipole moment of the molecule must change when the atoms are displaced relative to one another. Such vibrations are said to be infrared active. The classical basis of this rule is that the molecule can shake the electromagnetic field into oscillation if its dipole changes as it vibrates, and vice versa (Fig. 13.28); its formal basis is given in Further information 13.2. Note that the molecule need not have a permanent dipole: the rule requires only a change in dipole moment, possibly from zero. Some vibrations do not affect the molecule’s dipole moment (e.g. the stretching motion of a homonuclear diatomic molecule), so they neither absorb nor generate radiation: such vibrations are said to be infraredinactive. Homonuclear diatomic molecules are infrared inactive because their dipole moments remain zero however long the bond; heteronuclear diatomic molecules are infrared active. Illustration 13.4 Identifying infrared active molecules Of the molecules N2, CO2, OCS, H2O, CH2=CH2, and C6H6, all except N2 possess at least one vibrational mode that results in a change of dipole moment, so all except N2 can show a vibrational absorption spectrum. Not all the modes of complex molecules are vibrationally active. For example, the symmetric stretch of CO2, in which the O-C-O bonds stretch and contract symmetrically is inactive because it leaves the dipole moment unchanged (at zero). Self-test 13.6 Which of the molecules H2, NO, N2O, and CH4 have infrared active vibrations? [NO, N2O, CH4] The specific selection rule, which is obtained from an analysis of the expression for the transition moment and the properties of integrals over harmonic oscillator wavefunctions (as shown in Further information 13.2), is ∆v = ±1 (13.52) Transitions for which ∆v = +1 correspond to absorption and those with ∆v = −1 correspond to emission. 13.11 ANHARMONICITY 455 It follows from the specific selection rules that the wavenumbers of allowed vibrational transitions, which are denoted ∆Gv+1–– 2 for the transition v + 1 ← v, are ∆Gv+1–– 2 = G(v + 1) − G(v) = # (13.53) As we have seen, # lies in the infrared region of the electromagnetic spectrum, so vibrational transitions absorb and generate infrared radiation. At room temperature kT/hc ≈ 200 cm−1 , and most vibrational wavenumbers are significantly greater than 200 cm−1 . It follows from the Boltzmann distribution that almost all the molecules will be in their vibrational ground states initially. Hence, the dominant spectral transition will be the fundamental transition, 1 ← 0. As a result, the spectrum is expected to consist of a single absorption line. If the molecules are formed in a vibrationally excited state, such as when vibrationally excited HF molecules are formed in the reaction H2 + F2 → 2 HF*, the transitions 5 → 4, 4 → 3, . . . may also appear (in emission). In the harmonic approximation, all these lines lie at the same frequency, and the spectrum is also a single line. However, as we shall now show, the breakdown of the harmonic approximation causes the transitions to lie at slightly different frequencies, so several lines are observed. 13.11 Anharmonicity The vibrational terms in eqn 13.53 are only approximate because they are based on a parabolic approximation to the actual potential energy curve. A parabola cannot be correct at all extensions because it does not allow a bond to dissociate. At high vibrational excitations the swing of the atoms (more precisely, the spread of the vibrational wavefunction) allows the molecule to explore regions of the potential energy curve where the parabolic approximation is poor and additional terms in the Taylor expansion of V (eqn 13.45) must be retained. The motion then becomes anharmonic, in the sense that the restoring force is no longer proportional to the displacement. Because the actual curve is less confining than a parabola, we can anticipate that the energy levels become less widely spaced at high excitations. (a) The convergence of energy levels One approach to the calculation of the energy levels in the presence of anharmonicity is to use a function that resembles the true potential energy more closely. The Morse potential energy is V = hcDe{1 − e−a(R−Re) }2 a = 1/2 (13.54) where De is the depth of the potential minimum (Fig. 13.29). Near the well minimum the variation of V with displacement resembles a parabola (as can be checked by expanding the exponential as far as the first term) but, unlike a parabola, eqn 13.54 allows for dissociation at large displacements. The Schrödinger equation can be solved for the Morse potential and the permitted energy levels are G(v) = (v + 1 –2)# − (v + 1 –2)2 xe# xe = = (13.55) The parameter xe is called the anharmonicity constant. The number of vibrational levels of a Morse oscillator is finite, and v = 0, 1, 2, . . . , vmax, as shown in Fig. 13.30 (see also Problem 13.26). The second term in the expression for G subtracts from the first with increasing effect as v increases, and hence gives rise to the convergence of the levels at high quantum numbers. # 4De a2 $ 2meffω D F meffω2 2hcDe A C D0 De Displacement Potentialenergy 0 Fig. 13.29 The dissociation energy of a molecule, D0, differs from the depth of the potential well, De, on account of the zeropoint energy of the vibrations of the bond. –1 0 1 2 3 4 5 1 0 v = 0 1 2 3 4 vmax a R – R( )e VhcD/e Fig. 13.30 The Morse potential energy curve reproduces the general shape of a molecular potential energy curve. The corresponding Schrödinger equation can be solved, and the values of the energies obtained. The number of bound levels is finite. 456 13 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 1: ROTATIONAL AND VIBRATIONAL SPECTRA h1 h5 h2 h6 h3 h7 h4 h8 hhhhhhhhh=+++++++12345678 Fig. 13.31 The dissociation energy is the sum of the separations of the vibrational energy levels up to the dissociation limit just as the length of a ladder is the sum of the separations of its rungs. D¬Gvvv+1/2=(+1)~ Area (1 0)= ¬~ Linear extrapolation True curve v + n n 2 1 -2 1 - 2 3 - 2 5 Fig. 13.32 The area under a plot of transition wavenumber against vibrational quantum number is equal to the dissociation energy of the molecule. The assumption that the differences approach zero linearly is the basis of the Birge–Sponer extrapolation. Although the Morse oscillator is quite useful theoretically, in practice the more general expression G(v) = (v + 1 –2)# − (v + 1 –2)2 xe# + (v + 1 –2)3 ye# + · · · (13.56) where xe, ye, . . . are empirical dimensionless constants characteristic of the molecule, is used to fit the experimental data and to find the dissociation energy of the molecule. When anharmonicities are present, the wavenumbers of transitions with ∆v = +1 are ∆Gv+1–– 2 = # − 2(v + 1)xe# + · · · (13.57) Equation 13.57 shows that, when xe > 0, the transitions move to lower wavenumbers as v increases. Anharmonicity also accounts for the appearance of additional weak absorption lines corresponding to the transitions 2 ← 0, 3 ← 0, . . . , even though these first, second, . . . overtones are forbidden by the selection rule ∆v = ±1. The first overtone, for example, gives rise to an absorption at G(v + 2) − G(v) = 2# − 2(2v + 3)xe# + · · · (13.58) The reason for the appearance of overtones is that the selection rule is derived from the properties of harmonic oscillator wavefunctions, which are only approximately valid when anharmonicity is present. Therefore, the selection rule is also only an approximation. For an anharmonic oscillator, all values of ∆v are allowed, but transitions with ∆v > 1 are allowed only weakly if the anharmonicity is slight. (b) The Birge–Sponer plot When several vibrational transitions are detectable, a graphical technique called a Birge–Sponerplot may be used to determine the dissociation energy, D0, of the bond. The basis of the Birge–Sponer plot is that the sum of successive intervals ∆Gv+1–– 2 from the zero-point level to the dissociation limit is the dissociation energy: D0 = ∆G1/2 + ∆G3/2 + · · · = ∑v ∆Gv+1–– 2 (13.59) just as the height of the ladder is the sum of the separations of its rungs (Fig. 13.31). The construction in Fig. 13.32 shows that the area under the plot of ∆Gv+1–– 2 against v + 1 –2 is equal to the sum, and therefore to D0. The successive terms decrease linearly when only the xe anharmonicity constant is taken into account and the inaccessible part of the spectrum can be estimated by linear extrapolation. Most actual plots differ from the linear plot as shown in Fig. 13.32, so the value of D0 obtained in this way is usually an overestimate of the true value. Example 13.5 Using a Birge–Sponer plot The observed vibrational intervals of H2 + lie at the following values for 1 ← 0, 2 ← 1, . . . respectively(incm−1 ):2191,2064,1941,1821,1705,1591,1479,1368,1257,1145, 1033, 918, 800, 677, 548, 411. Determine the dissociation energy of the molecule. Method Plot the separations against v + 1 –2, extrapolate linearly to the point cutting the horizontal axis, and then measure the area under the curve. Answer The points are plotted in Fig. 13.33, and a linear extrapolation is shown as a dotted line. The area under the curve (use the formula for the area of a triangle or count the squares) is 214. Each square corresponds to 100 cm−1 (refer to the scale of the vertical axis); hence the dissociation energy is 21 400 cm−1 (corresponding to 256 kJ mol−1 ). 13.12 VIBRATION–ROTATION SPECTRA 457 2500 2000 1500 1000 500 0 v + /cm-1~ 2 1 –2 1 – 2 3 – 2 39 – n Fig. 13.33 The Birge–Sponer plot used in Example 13.5. The area is obtained simply by counting the squares beneath the line or using the formula for the area of a right triangle. 2800 3000 P-branch R-branch Q-branch 1 35 H Cl 1 37 H Cl /cm–1~ Absorbance n Fig. 13.34 A high-resolution vibration– rotation spectrum of HCl. The lines appear in pairs because H35 Cl and H37 Cl both contribute (their abundance ratio is 3:1). There is no Q branch, because ∆J = 0 is forbidden for this molecule. Self-test 13.7 The vibrational levels of HgH converge rapidly, and successive intervals are 1203.7 (which corresponds to the 1 ← 0 transition), 965.6, 632.4, and 172 cm−1 . Estimate the dissociation energy. [35.6 kJ mol−1 ] 13.12 Vibration–rotation spectra Each line of the high resolution vibrational spectrum of a gas-phase heteronuclear diatomic molecule is found to consist of a large number of closely spaced components (Fig. 13.34). Hence, molecular spectra are often called band spectra. The separation between the components is less than 10 cm−1 , which suggests that the structure is due to rotational transitions accompanying the vibrational transition. A rotational change should be expected because classically we can think of the transition as leading to a sudden increase or decrease in the instantaneous bond length. Just as ice-skaters rotate morerapidlywhentheybringtheirarmsin,andmoreslowlywhentheythrowthemout, so the molecular rotation is either accelerated or retarded by a vibrational transition. (a) Spectral branches A detailed analysis of the quantum mechanics of simultaneous vibrational and rotational changes shows that the rotational quantum number J changes by ±1 during the vibrational transition of a diatomic molecule. If the molecule also possesses angular momentum about its axis, as in the case of the electronic orbital angular momentum of the paramagnetic molecule NO, then the selection rules also allow ∆J = 0. The appearance of the vibration–rotation spectrum of a diatomic molecule can be discussed in terms of the combined vibration–rotation terms, S: S(v,J) = G(v) + F(J) (13.60) If we ignore anharmonicity and centrifugal distortion, S(v,J) = (v + 1 –2)# + BJ(J + 1) (13.61) 458 13 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 1: ROTATIONAL AND VIBRATIONAL SPECTRA In a more detailed treatment, B is allowed to depend on the vibrational state because, as v increases, the molecule swells slightly and the moment of inertia changes. We shall continue with the simple expression initially. When the vibrational transition v + 1 ← v occurs, J changes by ±1 and in some cases by 0 (when ∆J = 0 is allowed). The absorptions then fall into three groups called branches of the spectrum. The P branch consists of all transitions with ∆J = −1: #P(J) = S(v + 1, J − 1) − S(v,J) = # − 2BJ (13.62a) This branch consists of lines at # − 2B, # − 4B, . . . with an intensity distribution reflecting both the populations of the rotational levels and the magnitude of the J −1 ← J transition moment (Fig. 13.35). The Q branch consists of all lines with ∆J = 0, and its wavenumbers are all #Q(J) = S(v + 1, J) − S(v,J) = # (13.62b) for all values of J. This branch, when it is allowed (as in NO), appears at the vibrational transition wavenumber. In Fig. 13.35 there is a gap at the expected location of the Q branch because it is forbidden in HCl. The R branch consists of lines with ∆J = +1: #R(J) = S(v + 1, J + 1) − S(v,J) = # + 2B(J + 1) (13.62c) This branch consists of lines displaced from # to high wavenumber by 2B, 4B, . . . . The separation between the lines in the P and R branches of a vibrational transition gives the value of B. Therefore, the bond length can be deduced without needing to take a pure rotational microwave spectrum. However, the latter is more precise. (b) Combination differences The rotational constant of the vibrationally excited state, B1 (in general, Bv), is in fact slightly smaller than that of the ground vibrational state, B0, because the anharmonicity of the vibration results in a slightly extended bond in the upper state. As a result, the Q branch (if it exists) consists of a series of closely spaced lines. The lines of the R branch converge slightly as J increases; and those of the P branch diverge: #P(J) = # − (B1 + B0)J + (B1 − B0)J2 #Q(J) = # + (B1 − B0)J(J + 1) (13.63) #R(J) = # + (B1 + B0)(J + 1) + (B1 − B0)(J + 1)2 To determine the two rotational constants individually, we use the method of combinationdifferences. This procedure is used widely in spectroscopy to extract information about a particular state. It involves setting up expressions for the difference in the wavenumbers of transitions to a common state; the resulting expression then depends solely on properties of the other state. As can be seen from Fig. 13.36, the transitions #R(J − 1) and #P(J + 1) have a common upper state, and hence can be anticipated to depend on B0. Indeed, it is easy to show from eqn 13.63 that #R(J − 1) − #P(J + 1) = 4B0(J + 1 –2) (13.64a) Therefore, a plot of the combination difference against J + 1 –2 should be a straight line of slope 4B0, so the rotational constant of the molecule in the state v = 0 can be determined. (Any deviation from a straight line is a consequence of centrifugal distortion, so that effect can be investigated too.) Similarly, #R(J) and #P(J) have a common J 1+ J 1+ J J J 1J 1- R(1)J- P(1)J+ R()J P()J B 1 B0 n~ n~ n~ n~ Fig. 13.36 The method of combination differences makes use of the fact that some transitions share a common level. 0 0 1 1 2 2 3 3 4 4 5 5 6 6 7 7 8 8 9 9 v=1v=0 Frequency of absorbed radiation P Q R Molecular absorption on excitation Fig. 13.35 The formation of P, Q, and R branches in a vibration–rotation spectrum. The intensities reflect the populations of the initial rotational levels. 13.13 VIBRATIONAL RAMAN SPECTRA OF DIATOMIC MOLECULES 459 lower state, and hence their combination difference gives information about the upper state: #R(J) − #P(J) = 4B1(J + 1 –2) (13.64b) The two rotational constants of 1 H35 Cl found in this way are B0 = 10.440 cm−1 and B1 = 10.136 cm−1 . 13.13 Vibrational Raman spectra of diatomic molecules The gross selection rule for vibrational Raman transitions is that the polarizability should change as the molecule vibrates. As homonuclear and heteronuclear diatomic molecules swell and contract during a vibration, the control of the nuclei over the electrons varies, and hence the molecular polarizability changes. Both types of diatomic molecule are therefore vibrationally Raman active. The specific selection rule for vibrational Raman transitions in the harmonic approximation is ∆v = ±1. The formal basis for the gross and specific selection rules is given in Further information 13.2. The lines to high frequency of the incident radiation, the anti-Stokes lines, are those for which ∆v = −1. The lines to low frequency, the Stokes lines, correspond to ∆v = +1. The intensities of the anti-Stokes and Stokes lines are governed largely by the Boltzmann populations of the vibrational states involved in the transition. It follows that anti-Stokes lines are usually weak because very few molecules are in an excited vibrational state initially. In gas-phase spectra, the Stokes and anti-Stokes lines have a branch structure arising from the simultaneous rotational transitions that accompany the vibrational excitation (Fig. 13.37). The selection rules are ∆J = 0, ±2 (as in pure rotational Raman spectroscopy), and give rise to the O branch (∆J = −2), the Q branch (∆J = 0), and the S branch (∆J = +2): #O(J) = #i − # − 2B + 4BJ #Q(J) = #i − # (13.65) #S(J) = #i − # − 6B − 4BJ Note that, unlike in infrared spectroscopy, a Q branch is obtained for all linear molecules. The spectrum of CO, for instance, is shown in Fig. 13.38: the structure of the Q branch arises from the differences in rotational constants of the upper and lower vibrational states. The information available from vibrational Raman spectra adds to that from infrared spectroscopy because homonuclear diatomics can also be studied. The spectra can be interpreted in terms of the force constants, dissociation energies, and bond lengths, and some of the information obtained is included in Table 13.2. 0 0 1 1 2 2 3 3 4 4 5 5 6 6 7 7 8 8 9 9 v=1v=0 Frequency of scattered radiation QO S Molecular excitation during scattering Fig. 13.37 The formation of O, Q, and S branches in a vibration–rotation Raman spectrum of a linear rotor. Note that the frequency scale runs in the opposite direction to that in Fig. 13.35, because the higher energy transitions (on the right) extract more energy from the incident beam and leave it at lower frequency. Synoptic table 13.2* Properties of diatomic molecules #/cm−1 Re/pm B/cm−1 k/(N m−1 ) De/(kJ mol−1 ) 1 H2 4401 74 60.86 575 432 1 H35 Cl 2991 127 10.59 516 428 1 H127 I 2308 161 6.61 314 295 35 Cl2 560 199 0.244 323 239 * More values are given in the Data section. 460 13 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 1: ROTATIONAL AND VIBRATIONAL SPECTRA O Q S 21002200 D /cm 1~n Fig. 13.38 The structure of a vibrational line in the vibrational Raman spectrum of carbon monoxide, showing the O, Q, and S branches. q q f f y (a) (b) Fig. 13.39 (a) The orientation of a linear molecule requires the specification of two angles. (b) The orientation of a nonlinear molecule requires the specification of three angles. The vibrations of polyatomic molecules There is only one mode of vibration for a diatomic molecule, the bond stretch. In polyatomic molecules there are several modes of vibration because all the bond lengths and angles may change and the vibrational spectra are very complex. Nonetheless, we shall see that infrared and Raman spectroscopy can be used to obtain information about the structure of systems as large as animal and plant tissues (see Impact I13.3). 13.14 Normal modes We begin by calculating the total number of vibrational modes of a polyatomic molecule. We then see that we can choose combinations of these atomic displacements that give the simplest description of the vibrations. As shown in the Justification below, for a nonlinear molecule that consists of N atoms, there are 3N − 6 independent modes of vibration. If the molecule is linear, there are 3N − 5 independent vibrational modes. Justification 13.5 The number of vibrational modes The total number of coordinates needed to specify the locations of N atoms is 3N. Each atom may change its location by varying one of its three coordinates (x, y, and z), so the total number of displacements available is 3N. These displacements can be grouped together in a physically sensible way. For example, three coordinates are needed to specify the location of the centre of mass of the molecule, so three of the 3N displacements correspond to the translational motion of the molecule as a whole. The remaining 3N − 3 are non-translational ‘internal’ modes of the molecule. Two angles are needed to specify the orientation of a linear molecule in space: in effect, we need to give only the latitude and longitude of the direction in which the molecular axis is pointing (Fig. 13.39a). However, three angles are needed for a nonlinear molecule because we also need to specify the orientation of the molecule around the direction defined by the latitude and longitude (Fig. 13.39b). Therefore, two (linear) or three (nonlinear) of the 3N − 3 internal displacements are rotational. This leaves 3N − 5 (linear) or 3N − 6 (nonlinear) displacements of the atoms relative to one another: these are the vibrational modes. It follows that the number of modes of vibration Nvib is 3N − 5 for linear molecules and 3N − 6 for nonlinear molecules. Illustration 13.5 Determining the number of vibrational modes Water, H2O, is a nonlinear triatomic molecule, and has three modes of vibration (and three modes of rotation); CO2 is a linear triatomic molecule, and has four modes of vibration (and only two modes of rotation). Even a middle-sized molecule such as naphthalene (C10H8) has 48 distinct modes of vibration. The next step is to find the best description of the modes. One choice for the four modes of CO2, for example, might be the ones in Fig. 13.40a. This illustration shows the stretching of one bond (the mode νL), the stretching of the other (νR), and the two perpendicular bending modes (ν2). The description, while permissible, has a 13.15 INFRARED ABSORPTION SPECTRA OF POLYATOMIC MOLECULES 461 disadvantage: when one CO bond vibration is excited, the motion of the C atom sets the other CO bond in motion, so energy flows backwards and forwards between νL and νR. Moreover, the position of the centre of mass of the molecule varies in the course of either vibration. The description of the vibrational motion is much simpler if linear combinations of νL and νR are taken. For example, one combination is ν1 in Fig. 13.40b: this mode is the symmetricstretch. In this mode, the C atom is buffeted simultaneously from each side and the motion continues indefinitely. Another mode is ν3, the antisymmetric stretch, in which the two O atoms always move in the same direction and opposite to that of the C atom. Both modes are independent in the sense that, if one is excited, then it does not excite the other. They are two of the ‘normal modes’ of the molecule, its independent, collective vibrational displacements. The two other normal modes are the bending modes ν2. In general, a normalmode is an independent, synchronous motion of atoms or groups of atoms that may be excited without leading to the excitation of any other normal mode and without involving translation or rotation of the molecule as a whole. The four normal modes of CO2, and the Nvib normal modes of polyatomics in general, are the key to the description of molecular vibrations. Each normal mode, q, behaves like an independent harmonic oscillator (if anharmonicities are neglected), so each has a series of terms Gq(v) = (v + 1 –2)#q #q = 1/2 (13.66) where #q is the wavenumber of mode q and depends on the force constant kq for the mode and on the effective mass mq of the mode. The effective mass of the mode is a measure of the mass that is swung about by the vibration and in general is a complicated function of the masses of the atoms. For example, in the symmetric stretch of CO2, the C atom is stationary, and the effective mass depends on the masses of only the O atoms. In the antisymmetric stretch and in the bends, all three atoms move, so all contribute to the effective mass. The three normal modes of H2O are shown in Fig. 13.41: note that the predominantly bending mode (ν2) has a lower frequency than the others, which are predominantly stretching modes. It is generally the case that the frequencies of bending motions are lower than those of stretching modes. One point that must be appreciated is that only in special cases (such as the CO2 molecule) are the normal modes purely stretches or purely bends. In general, a normal mode is a composite motion of simultaneous stretching and bending of bonds. Another point in this connection is that heavy atoms generally move less than light atoms in normal modes. 13.15 Infrared absorption spectra of polyatomic molecules The gross selection rule for infrared activity is that the motion corresponding to a normal mode should be accompanied by a change of dipole moment. Deciding whether this is so can sometimes be done by inspection. For example, the symmetric stretch of CO2 leaves the dipole moment unchanged (at zero, see Fig. 13.40), so this mode is infrared inactive. The antisymmetric stretch, however, changes the dipole moment because the molecule becomes unsymmetrical as it vibrates, so this mode is infrared active. Because the dipole moment change is parallel to the principal axis, the transitions arising from this mode are classified as parallel bands in the spectrum. Both bending modes are infrared active: they are accompanied by a changing dipole perpendicular to the principal axis, so transitions involving them lead to a perpendicular band in the spectrum. The latter bands eliminate the linearity of the molecule, and as a result a Q branch is observed; a parallel band does not have a Q branch. D F kq mq A C 1 2πc L R 1 (1388 cm ) -1 3 (2349 cm ) -1 2 (667 cm ) 1 (c) (b) (a) n n n n n Fig. 13.40 Alternative descriptions of the vibrations of CO2. (a) The stretching modes are not independent, and if one C-O group is excited the other begins to vibrate. They are not normal modes of vibration of the molecule. (b) The symmetric and antisymmetric stretches are independent, and one can be excited without affecting the other: they are normal modes. (c) The two perpendicular bending motions are also normal modes. 1 (3652 cm ) -1 2 (1595 cm ) 1 3 (3756 cm ) -1 n n n Fig. 13.41 The three normal modes of H2O. The mode ν2 is predominantly bending, and occurs at lower wavenumber than the other two. 462 13 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 1: ROTATIONAL AND VIBRATIONAL SPECTRA The active modes are subject to the specific selection rule ∆vq = ±1 in the harmonic approximation, so the wavenumber of the fundamental transition (the ‘first harmonic’) of each active mode is #q. From the analysis of the spectrum, a picture may be constructed of the stiffness of various parts of the molecule, that is, we can establish its force field, the set of force constants corresponding to all the displacements of the atoms. The force field may also be estimated by using the semi-empirical, ab initio, and DFT computational techniques described in Section 11.7. Superimposed on the simple force field scheme are the complications arising from anharmonicities and the effects of molecular rotation. Very often the sample is a liquid or a solid, and the molecules are unable to rotate freely. In a liquid, for example, a molecule may be able to rotate through only a few degrees before it is struck by another, so it changes its rotational state frequently. This random changing of orientation is called tumbling. The lifetimes of rotational states in liquids are very short, so in most cases the rotational energies are ill-defined. Collisions occur at a rate of about 1013 s−1 and, even allowing for only a 10 per cent success rate in knocking the molecule into another rotational state, a lifetime broadening (eqn 13.19) of more than 1 cm−1 can easily result. The rotational structure of the vibrational spectrum is blurred by this effect, so the infrared spectra of molecules in condensed phases usually consist of broad lines spanning the entire range of the resolved gas-phase spectrum, and showing no branch structure. One very important application of infrared spectroscopy to condensed phase samples, and for which the blurring of the rotational structure by random collisions is a welcome simplification, is to chemical analysis. The vibrational spectra of different groups in a molecule give rise to absorptions at characteristic frequencies because a normal mode of even a very large molecule is often dominated by the motion of a small group of atoms. The intensities of the vibrational bands that can be identified with the motions of small groups are also transferable between molecules. Consequently, the molecules in a sample can often be identified by examining its infrared spectrum and referring to a table of characteristic frequencies and intensities (Table 13.3). IMPACT ON ENVIRONMENTAL SCIENCE I13.2 Global warming1 Solar energy strikes the top of the Earth’s atmosphere at a rate of 343 W m−2 . About 30 per cent of this energy is reflected back into space by the Earth or the atmosphere. The Earth–atmosphere system absorbs the remaining energy and re-emits it into space as black-body radiation, with most of the intensity being carried by infrared radiation in the range 200–2500 cm−1 (4–50 µm). The Earth’s average temperature is maintained by an energy balance between solar radiation absorbed by the Earth and black-body radiation emitted by the Earth. The trapping of infrared radiation by certain gases in the atmosphere is known as the greenhouse effect, so called because it warms the Earth as if the planet were enclosed in a huge greenhouse. The result is that the natural greenhouse effect raises the average surface temperature well above the freezing point of water and creates an environment in which life is possible. The major constituents to the Earth’s atmosphere, O2 and N2, do not contribute to the greenhouse effect because homonuclear diatomic molecules cannot absorb infrared radiation. However, the minor atmospheric gases, water vapour and CO2, do absorb infrared radiation and hence are responsible for the Comment 13.6 The web site for this text contains links to sites where you can perform quantum mechanical calculations of frequencies and atomic displacements of normal modes of simple molecules. Comment 13.7 The web site for this text contains links to databases of infrared spectra. Synoptic table 13.3* Typical vibrational wavenumbers Vibration type #/cm−1 C-H stretch 2850–2960 C-H bend 1340–1465 C-C stretch, bend 700–1250 C=C stretch 1620–1680 * More values are given in the Data section. 1 This section is based on a similar contribution initially prepared by Loretta Jones and appearing in Chemical principles, Peter Atkins and Loretta Jones, W.H. Freeman and Co., New York (2005). I13.2 IMPACT ON ENVIRONMENTAL SCIENCE: GLOBAL WARMING 463 greenhouse effect (Fig. 13.42). Water vapour absorbs strongly in the ranges 1300– 1900 cm−1 (5.3–7.7 µm) and 3550–3900 cm−1 (2.6–2.8 µm), whereas CO2 shows strong absorption in the ranges 500–725 cm−1 (14–20 µm) and 2250–2400 cm−1 (4.2–4.4 µm). Increases in the levels of greenhouse gases, which also include methane, dinitrogen oxide, ozone, and certain chlorofluorocarbons, as a result of human activity have the potential to enhance the natural greenhouse effect, leading to significant warming of the planet. This problem is referred to as global warming, which we now explore in some detail. The concentration of water vapour in the atmosphere has remained steady over time, but concentrations of some other greenhouse gases are rising. From about the year 1000 until about 1750, the CO2 concentration remained fairly stable, but, since then, it has increased by 28 per cent. The concentration of methane, CH4, has more than doubled during this time and is now at its highest level for 160 000 years (160 ka; a is the SI unit denoting 1 year). Studies of air pockets in ice cores taken from Antarctica show that increases in the concentration of both atmospheric CO2 and CH4 over the past 160 ka correlate well with increases in the global surface temperature. Humanactivitiesareprimarilyresponsiblefortherisingconcentrationsofatmospheric CO2 and CH4. Most of the atmospheric CO2 comes from the burning of hydrocarbon fuels, which began on a large scale with the Industrial Revolution in the middle of the nineteenth century. The additional methane comes mainly from the petroleum industry and from agriculture. The temperature of the surface of the Earth has increased by about 0.5 K since the late nineteenth century (Fig. 13.43). If we continue to rely on hydrocarbon fuels and current trends in population growth and energy are not reversed, then by the middle of the twenty-first century, the concentration of CO2 in the atmosphere will be about twice its value prior to the Industrial Revolution. The Intergovernmental Panel on Climate Change (IPCC) estimated in 1995 that, by the year 2100, the Earth will undergo an increase in temperature of 3 K. Furthermore, the rate of temperature change is likely to be greater than at any time in the last 10 ka. To place a temperature rise of 3 K in perspective, it is useful to consider that the average temperature of the Earth during the last ice age was only 6 K colder than at present. Just as cooling the planet (for example, during an ice age) can lead to detrimental effects on ecosystems, so too can a dramatic warming of the globe. One example of a significant change in the Lightintensity H O2 CH4 O3 CO2 H O2 7.1 10.0 16.7 Wavelength, mlm Fig. 13.42 The intensity of infrared radiation that would be lost from Earth in the absence of greenhouse gases is shown by the blue line. The purple line is the intensity of the radiation actually emitted. The maximum wavelength of radiation absorbed by each greenhouse gas is indicated. 0.8 0.6 0.4 0.2 0 -0.2 -0.4 -0.6 -0.8 -1 Monthlytemperature (°C,relativeto19611990)- 1850 1860 1870 1880 1890 1900 1910 1920 1930 1940 1950 1960 1970 1980 1990 2000 2010 Year Fig. 13.43 The average change in surface temperature of the Earth from 1855 to 2002. 464 13 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 1: ROTATIONAL AND VIBRATIONAL SPECTRA environment caused by a temperature increase of 3 K is a rise in sea level by about 0.5 m, which is sufficient to alter weather patterns and submerge currently coastal ecosystems. Computer projections for the next 200 years predict further increases in atmospheric CO2 levels and suggest that, to maintain CO2 at its current concentration, we would have to reduce hydrocarbon fuel consumption immediately by about 50 per cent. Clearly, in order to reverse global warming trends, we need to develop alternatives to fossil fuels, such as hydrogen (which can be used in fuel cells, Impact I25.3) and solar energy technologies. 13.16 Vibrational Raman spectra of polyatomic molecules The normal modes of vibration of molecules are Raman active if they are accompanied by a changing polarizability. It is sometimes quite difficult to judge by inspection when this is so. The symmetric stretch of CO2, for example, alternately swells and contracts the molecule: this motion changes the polarizability of the molecule, so the mode is Raman active. The other modes of CO2 leave the polarizability unchanged, so they are Raman inactive. A more exact treatment of infrared and Raman activity of normal modes leads to the exclusion rule: If the molecule has a centre of symmetry, then no modes can be both infrared and Raman active. (A mode may be inactive in both.) Because it is often possible to judge intuitively if a mode changes the molecular dipole moment, we can use this rule to identify modes that are not Raman active. The rule applies to CO2 but to neither H2O nor CH4 because they have no centre of symmetry. In general, it is necessary to use group theory to predict whether a mode is infrared or Raman active (Section 13.17). (a) Depolarization The assignment of Raman lines to particular vibrational modes is aided by noting the state of polarization of the scattered light. The depolarization ratio, ρ, of a line is the ratio of the intensities, I, of the scattered light with polarizations perpendicular and parallel to the plane of polarization of the incident radiation: ρ = [13.67] To measure ρ, the intensity of a Raman line is measured with a polarizing filter (a ‘half-wave plate’) first parallel and then perpendicular to the polarization of the incident beam. If the emergent light is not polarized, then both intensities are the same and ρ is close to 1; if the light retains its initial polarization, then I⊥ = 0, so ρ = 0 (Fig. 13.44). A line is classified as depolarized if it has ρ close to or greater than 0.75 and as polarized if ρ < 0.75. Only totally symmetrical vibrations give rise to polarized lines in which the incident polarization is largely preserved. Vibrations that are not totally symmetrical give rise to depolarized lines because the incident radiation can give rise to radiation in the perpendicular direction too. (b) Resonance Raman spectra A modification of the basic Raman effect involves using incident radiation that nearly coincides with the frequency of an electronic transition of the sample (Fig. 13.45). The I⊥ I|| Incident radiation Scattered radiation I|| I^ Fig. 13.44 The definition of the planes used for the specification of the depolarization ratio, ρ, in Raman scattering. Energy Incident radiation Scattered resonance radiation Fig. 13.45 In the resonance Raman effect, the incident radiation has a frequency corresponding to an actual electronic excitation of the molecule. A photon is emitted when the excited state returns to a state close to the ground state. 13.16 VIBRATIONAL RAMAN SPECTRA OF POLYATOMIC MOLECULES 465 technique is then called resonance Raman spectroscopy. It is characterized by a much greater intensity in the scattered radiation. Furthermore, because it is often the case that only a few vibrational modes contribute to the more intense scattering, the spectrum is greatly simplified. Resonance Raman spectroscopy is used to study biological molecules that absorb strongly in the ultraviolet and visible regions of the spectrum. Examples include the pigments β-carotene and chlorophyll, which capture solar energy during plant photosynthesis (see Impact I23.2). The resonance Raman spectra of Fig. 13.46 show vibrational transitions from only the few pigment molecules that are bound to very large proteins dissolved in an aqueous buffer solution. This selectivity arises from the fact that water (the solvent), amino acid residues, and the peptide group do not have electronic transitions at the laser wavelengths used in the experiment, so their conventional Raman spectra are weak compared to the enhanced spectra of the pigments. Comparison of the spectra in Figs. 13.46a and 13.46b also shows that, with proper choice of excitation wavelength, it is possible to examine individual classes of pigments bound to the same protein: excitation at 488 nm, where β-carotene absorbs strongly, shows vibrational bands from β-carotene only, whereas excitation at 442 nm, where chlorophyll a and β-carotene absorb, reveals features from both types of pigments. (c) Coherent anti-Stokes Raman spectroscopy The intensity of Raman transitions may be enhanced by coherent anti-Stokes Raman spectroscopy (CARS, Fig. 13.47). The technique relies on the fact that, if two laser beams of frequencies ν1 and ν2 pass through a sample, then they may mix together and give rise to coherent radiation of several different frequencies, one of which is ν′ = 2ν1 − ν2 (13.68) Suppose that ν2 is varied until it matches any Stokes line from the sample, such as the one with frequency ν1 − ∆ν; then the coherent emission will have frequency ν′ = 2ν1 − (ν1 − ∆ν) = ν1 + ∆ν (13.69) which is the frequency of the corresponding anti-Stokes line. This coherent radiation forms a narrow beam of high intensity. An advantage of CARS is that it can be used to study Raman transitions in the presence of competing incoherent background radiation, and so can be used to observe the Raman spectra of species in flames. One example is the vibration–rotation CARS spectrum of N2 gas in a methane–air flame shown in Fig 13.48. Raman shift / cm -1 130015501800 (a) (b) Lightintensity Fig. 13.46 The resonance Raman spectra of a protein complex that is responsible for some of the initial electron transfer events in plant photosynthesis. (a) Laser excitation of the sample at 407 nm shows Raman bands due to both chlorophyll a and β-carotene bound to the protein because both pigments absorb light at this wavelength. (b) Laser excitation at 488 nm shows Raman bands from β-carotene only because chlorophyll a does not absorb light very strongly at this wavelength. (Adapted from D.F. Ghanotakis et al., Biochim. Biophys. Acta 974, 44 (1989).) Laser 1 11 2 3 Dye laser Detector Sample n n n n n Intensity / cm -1~ 21070 21090 21110 21130 n Fig. 13.47 The experimental arrangement for the CARS experiment. Fig. 13.48 CARS spectrum of a methane–air flame at 2104 K. The peaks correspond to the Q branch of the vibration–rotation spectrum of N2 gas. (Adapted from J.F. Verdieck et al., J. Chem. Educ. 59, 495 (1982).) 466 13 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 1: ROTATIONAL AND VIBRATIONAL SPECTRA IMPACT ON BIOCHEMISTRY I13.3 Vibrational microscopy Optical microscopes can now be combined with infrared and Raman spectrometers and the vibrational spectra of specimens as small as single biological cells obtained. The techniques of vibrational microscopy provide details of cellular events that cannot be observed with traditional light or electron microscopy. The principles behind the operation of infrared and Raman microscopes are simple: radiation illuminates a small area of the sample, and the transmitted, reflected, or scattered light is first collected by a microscope and then analysed by a spectrometer. The sample is then moved by very small increments along a plane perpendicular to the direction of illumination and the process is repeated until vibrational spectra for all sections the sample are obtained. The size of a sample that can be studied by vibrational microscopy depends on a number of factors, such as the area of illumination and the excitance and wavelength of the incident radiation. Up to a point, the smaller theareathatisilluminated,thesmallertheareafromwhichaspectrumcanbeobtained. High excitance is required to increase the rate of arrival of photons at the detector from small illuminated areas. For this reason, lasers and synchrotron radiation (see Further information 13.1) are the preferred radiation sources. In a conventional light microscope, an image is constructed from a pattern of diffracted light waves that emanate from the illuminated object. As a result, some information about the specimen is lost by destructive interference of scattered light waves. Ultimately, this diffraction limit prevents the study of samples that are much smaller than the wavelength of light used as a probe. In practice, two objects will appear as distinct images under a microscope if the distance between their centres is greater than the Airy radius, rAiry = 0.61λ/a, where λ is the wavelength of the incident beam of radiation and a is the numerical aperture of the objective lens, the lens that collects light scattered by the object. The numerical aperture of the objective lens is defined as a = nr sin α, where nr is the refractive index of the lens material (the greater the refractive index, the greater the bending of a ray of light by the lens) and the angle α is the half-angle of the widest cone of scattered light that can collected by the lens (so the lens collects light beams sweeping a cone with angle 2α). Use of the best equipment makes it possible to probe areas as small as 9 µm2 by vibrational microscopy. Figure 13.49 shows the infrared spectra of a single mouse cell, living and dying. Both spectra have features at 1545 cm−1 and 1650 cm−1 that are due to the peptide carbonyl groups of proteins and a feature at 1240 cm−1 that is due to the phosphodiester (PO2 − ) groups of lipids. The dying cell shows an additional absorption at 1730 cm−1 , which is due to the ester carbonyl group from an unidentified compound. From a plot of the intensities of individual absorption features as a function of position in the cell, it has been possible to map the distribution of proteins and lipids during cell division and cell death. Vibrational microscopy has also been used in biomedical and pharmaceutical laboratories. Examples include the determination of the size and distribution of a drug in a tablet, the observation of conformational changes in proteins of cancerous cells upon administration of anti-tumour drugs, and the measurement of differences between diseased and normal tissue, such as diseased arteries and the white matter from brains of multiple sclerosis patients. 13.17 Symmetry aspects of molecular vibrations One of the most powerful ways of dealing with normal modes, especially of complex molecules, is to classify them according to their symmetries. Each normal mode must NH and OH stretch Aliphatic C H stretch - Amide PO asymmetric stretch 2 4000 3000 2000 1000 Absorptionintensity CO ester Wavenumber, /cm -1~ - n Fig. 13.49 Infrared absorption spectra of a single mouse cell: (purple) living cell, (blue) dying cell. Adapted from N. Jamin et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci.USA 95, 4837 (1998). 13.17 SYMMETRY ASPECTS OF MOLECULAR VIBRATIONS 467 x y z C ,S2 4 d 1 4 C3 2 3 s 1 1(A ) 2 (E) 3 2(T ) 4 2(T ) n n n n Fig. 13.50 The atomic displacements of CH4 and the symmetry elements used to calculate the characters. Fig. 13.51 Typical normal modes of vibration of a tetrahedral molecule. There are in fact two modes of symmetry species E and three modes of each T2 symmetry species. belong to one of the symmetry species of the molecular point group, as discussed in Chapter 12. Example 13.6 Identifying the symmetry species of a normal mode Establish the symmetry species of the normal mode vibrations of CH4, which belongs to the group Td. Method The first step in the procedure is to identify the symmetry species of the irreducible representations spanned by all the 3N displacements of the atoms, using the characters of the molecular point group. Find these characters by counting 1 if the displacement is unchanged under a symmetry operation, −1 if it changes sign, and 0 if it is changed into some other displacement. Next, subtract the symmetry species of the translations. Translational displacements span the same symmetry species as x, y, and z, so they can be obtained from the right-most column of the character table. Finally, subtract the symmetry species of the rotations, which are also given in the character table (and denoted there by Rx, Ry, or Rz). Answer There are 3 × 5 = 15 degrees of freedom, of which (3 × 5) − 6 = 9 are vibrations. Refer to Fig. 13.50. Under E, no displacement coordinates are changed, so the character is 15. Under C3, no displacements are left unchanged, so the character is 0. Under the C2 indicated, the z-displacement of the central atom is left unchanged, whereas its x- and y-components both change sign. Therefore χ(C2) = 1 − 1 − 1 + 0 + 0 + · · · = −1. Under the S4 indicated, the z-displacement of the central atom is reversed, so χ(S4) = −1. Under σd, the x- and z-displacements of C, H3, and H4 are left unchanged and the y-displacements are reversed; hence χ(σd) = 3 + 3 − 3 = 3. The characters are therefore 15, 0, −1, −1, 3. By decomposing the direct product (Section 12.5a), we find that this representation spans A1 + E + T1 + 3T2. The translations span T2; the rotations span T1. Hence, the nine vibrations span A1 + E + 2T2. The modes themselves are shown in Fig. 13.51. We shall see that symmetry analysis gives a quick way of deciding which modes are active. Self-test 13.8 Establish the symmetry species of the normal modes of H2O. [2A1 + B2] (a) Infrared activity of normal modes It is best to use group theory to judge the activities of more complex modes of vibration. This is easily done by checking the character table of the molecular point group for the symmetry species of the irreducible representations spanned by x, y, and z, for their species are also the symmetry species of the components of the electric dipole moment. Then apply the following rule: If the symmetry species of a normal mode is the same as any of the symmetry species of x, y, or z, then the mode is infrared active. Justification 13.6 Using group theory to identify infrared active normal modes The rule hinges on the form of the transition dipole moment between the groundstate vibrational wavefunction, ψ0, and that of the first excited state, ψ1. The x-component is 468 13 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 1: ROTATIONAL AND VIBRATIONAL SPECTRA µx,10 = −eΎψ*1xψ0 dτ (13.70) with similar expressions for the two other components of the transition moment. The ground-state vibrational wavefunction is a Gaussian function of the form e−x2 , so it is symmetrical in x. The wavefunction for the first excited state gives a nonvanishing integral only if it is proportional to x, for then the integrand is proportional to x2 rather than to xy or xz. Consequently, the excited state wavefunction must have the same symmetry as the displacement x. Example 13.7 Identifying infrared active modes Which modes of CH4 are infrared active? Method Refer to the Td character table to establish the symmetry species of x, y, and z for this molecule, and then use the rule given above. Answer The functions x, y, and z span T2. We found in Example13.6 that the symmetry species of the normal modes are A1 + E + 2T2. Therefore, only the T2 modes are infrared active. The distortions accompanying these modes lead to a changing dipole moment. The A1 mode, which is inactive, is the symmetrical ‘breathing’ mode of the molecule. Self-test 13.9 Which of the normal modes of H2O are infrared active? [All three] (b) Raman activity of normal modes Group theory provides an explicit recipe for judging the Raman activity of a normal mode. In this case, the symmetry species of the quadratic forms (x2 , xy, etc.) listed in the character table are noted (they transform in the same way as the polarizability), and then we use the following rule: If the symmetry species of a normal mode is the same as the symmetry species of a quadratic form, then the mode is Raman active. Illustration 13.6 Identifying Raman active modes To decide which of the vibrations of CH4 are Raman active, refer to the Td character table. It was established in Example 13.6 that the symmetry species of the normal modes are A1 + E + 2T2. Because the quadratic forms span A1 + E + T2, all the normal modes are Raman active. By combining this information with that in Example 13.6, we see how the infrared and Raman spectra of CH4 are assigned. The assignment of spectral features to the T2 modes is straightforward because these are the only modes that are both infrared and Raman active. This leaves the A1 and E modes to be assigned in the Raman spectrum. Measurement of the depolarization ratio distinguishes between these modes because the A1 mode, being totally symmetric, is polarized and the E mode is depolarized. Self-test 13.10 Which of the vibrational modes of H2O are Raman active? [All three] CHECKLIST OF KEY IDEAS 469 Checklist of key ideas 1. Emission spectroscopy is based on the detection of a transition from a state of high energy to a state of lower energy; absorption spectroscopy is based on the detection of the net absorption of nearly monochromatic incident radiation as the radiation is swept over a range of frequencies. 2. In Raman spectroscopy molecular energy levels are explored by examining the frequencies present in scattered radiation. Stokes and anti-Stokes radiation are scattered radiation at a lower and higher frequency, respectively, than the incident radiation. Rayleigh radiation is the component of radiation scattered into the forward direction without change of frequency. 3. The Beer–Lambert law is I(#) = I0(#)10−ε(#)[J]l , where I(#) is the transmitted intensity, I0(#) is the incident intensity, and ε(#) is the molar absorption coefficient. 4. The transmittance, T = I/I0, and the absorbance, A, of a sample at a given wavenumber are related by A = −log T. 5. The integrated absorption coefficient, A, is the sum of the absorption coefficients over the entire band, A = ∫band ε(#)d#. 6. Stimulated absorption is the radiation-driven transition from a low energy state to one of higher energy. Stimulated emission is the radiation-driven transition from a high energy state to one of lower energy. Spontaneous emission is radiative emission independent of the intensity of the radiation (of any frequency) that is already present. 7. The natural linewidth of a spectral line is due to spontaneous emission. Spectral lines are affected by Doppler broadening, lifetime broadening, and collisional deactivation of excited states. 8. A rigid rotor is a body that does not distort under the stress of rotation. A spherical rotor is a rigid rotor with three equal moments of inertia. A symmetric rotor is a rigid rotor with two equal moments of inertia. A linear rotor is a rigid rotor with one moment of inertia equal to zero. An asymmetric rotor is a rigid rotor with three different moments of inertia. 9. The rotational terms of a spherical rotor are F(J) = BJ(J + 1) with B = $/4πcI, J = 0, 1, 2, . . . , and are (2J + 1)2 -fold degenerate. 10. The principal axis (figure axis) is the unique axis of a symmetric top. In an oblate top, I|| > I⊥. In a prolate top, I|| < I⊥. 11. The rotational terms of a symmetric rotor are F(J,K) = BJ(J + 1) + (A − B)K2 , J = 0, 1, 2, . . . , K = 0, ±1, . . . , ±J. 12. The rotational terms of a linear rotor are F(J) = BJ(J + 1), J = 0, 1, 2, . . . and are (2J + 1)-fold degenerate. 13. The centrifugal distortion constant, DJ, is the empirical constant in the expression F(J) = BJ(J + 1) − DJJ2 (J + 1)2 that takes into account centrifugal distortion, DJ ≈ 4B3 /#2 . 14. The gross rotational selection rule for microwave spectra is: for a molecule to give a pure rotational spectrum, it must be polar. The specific rotational selection rule is: ∆J = ±1, ∆MJ = 0, ±1, ∆K = 0. The rotational wavenumbers in the absence and presence of centrifugal distortion are given by eqns 13.37 and 13.38, respectively. 15. The gross selection rule for rotational Raman spectra is: the molecule must be anisotropically polarizable. The specific selection rules are: (i) linear rotors, ∆J = 0, ±2; (ii) symmetric rotors, ∆J = 0, ±1, ±2; ∆K = 0. 16. The appearance of rotational spectra is affected by nuclear statistics, the selective occupation of rotational states that stems from the Pauli principle. 17. The vibrational energy levels of a diatomic molecule modelled as a harmonic oscillator are Ev = (v + 1 –2)$ω, ω = (k/meff)1/2 ; the vibrational terms are G(v) = (v + 1 –2)#, # =(1/2πc)(k/meff)1/2 . 18. The gross selection rule for infrared spectra is: the electric dipole moment of the molecule must change when the atoms are displaced relative to one another. The specific selection rule is: ∆v = ±1. 19. Morse potential energy, eqn 13.54, describes anharmonic motion, oscillatory motion in which the restoring force is not proportional to the displacement; the vibrational terms of a Morse oscillator are given by eqn 13.55. 20. A Birge–Sponer plot is a graphical procedure for determining the dissociation energy of a bond. 21. The P branch consists of vibration–rotation infrared transitions with ∆J = −1; the Q branch has transitions with ∆J = 0; the R branch has transitions with ∆J = +1. 22. The gross selection rule for vibrational Raman spectra is: the polarizability must change as the molecule vibrates. The specific selection rule is: ∆v = ±1. 23. A normal mode is an independent, synchronous motion of atoms or groups of atoms that may be excited without leading to the excitation of any other normal mode. The number of normal modes is 3N − 6 (for nonlinear molecules) or 3N − 5 (linear molecules). 24. A symmetric stretch is a symmetrically stretching vibrational mode. An antisymmetric stretch is a stretching mode, one half of which is the mirror image of the other half. 25. The exclusion rule states that, if the molecule has a centre of symmetry, then no modes can be both infrared and Raman active. 26. The depolarization ratio, ρ, the ratio of the intensities, I, of the scattered light with polarizations perpendicular and parallel to the plane of polarization of the incident radiation, ρ = I⊥/I||. A depolarized line is a line with ρ close to or greater than 0.75. A polarized line is a line with ρ < 0.75. 27. Resonance Raman spectroscopy is a Raman technique in which the frequency of the incident radiation nearly coincides with the frequency of an electronic transition of the sample. Coherent anti-Stokes Raman spectroscopy (CARS) is a 470 13 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 1: ROTATIONAL AND VIBRATIONAL SPECTRA Raman technique that relies on the use of two incident beams of radiation. 28. A normal mode is infrared active if its symmetry species is the same as any of the symmetry species of x, y, or z, then the mode is infrared active. A normal mode is Raman active if its symmetry species is the same as the symmetry species of a quadratic form. Further reading Articles and texts L. Glasser, Fourier transforms for chemists. Part I. Introduction to the Fourier transform. J. Chem. Educ. 64, A228 (1987). Part II. Fourier transforms in chemistry and spectroscopy. J. Chem. Educ. 64, A260 (1987). H.-U. Gremlich and B. Yan, Infrared and Raman spectroscopy of biological materials. Marcel Dekker, New York (2001). G. Herzberg, Molecular spectra and molecular structure I. Spectra of diatomic molecules. Krieger, Malabar (1989). G. Herzberg, Molecular spectra and molecular structure II. Infrared and Raman spectra of polyatomic molecules. Van Nostrand–Reinhold, New York (1945). J.C. Lindon, G.E. Tranter, and J.L. Holmes (ed.), Encyclopedia of spectroscopy and spectrometry. Academic Press, San Diego (2000). D.P. Strommen, Specific values of the depolarization ratio in Raman spectroscopy: Their origins and significance. J. Chem. Educ. 69, 803 (1992). E.B. Wilson, J.C. Decius, and P.C. Cross, Molecular vibrations. Dover, New York (1980). J.M. Brown and A. Carrington, Rotational spectroscopy of diatomic molecules. Cambridge University Press (2003). Sources of data and information M.E. Jacox, Vibrational and electronic energy levels of polyatomic transient molecules. Journal of Physical and Chemical Reference Data, Monograph No. 3 (1994). K.P. Huber and G. Herzberg, Molecular spectra and molecular structure IV. Constants of diatomic molecules. Van NostrandReinhold, New York (1979). B. Schrader, Raman/IR atlas of organic compounds. VCH, New York (1989). G. Socrates, Infrared and Raman characteristic group frequencies: tables and charts. Wiley, New York (2000). Further information Further information 13.1 Spectrometers Here we provide additional detail on the principles of operation of spectrometers, describing radiation sources, dispersing elements, detectors, and Fourier transform techniques. Sources of radiation Sources of radiation are either monochromatic, those spanning a very narrow range of frequencies around a central value, or polychromatic, those spanning a wide range of frequencies. Monochromatic sources that can be tuned over a range of frequencies include the klystron and the Gunn diode, which operate in the microwave range, and lasers, which are discussed in Chapter 14. Polychromatic sources that take advantage of black-body radiation from hot materials. For far infrared radiation with 35 cm−1 < # < 200 cm−1 , a typical source is a mercury arc inside a quartz envelope, most of the radiation being generated by the hot quartz. Either a Nernst filament or a globar is used as a source of mid-infrared radiation with 200 cm−1 < # < 4000 cm−1 . The Nernst filament consists of a ceramic filament of lanthanoid oxides that is heated to temperatures ranging from 1200 to 2000 K. The globar consists of a rod of silicon carbide, which is heated electrically to about 1500 K. A quartz–tungsten–halogen lamp consists of a tungsten filament that, when heated to about 3000 K, emits light in the range 320 nm < λ < 2500 nm. Near the surface of the lamp’s quartz envelope, iodine atoms and tungsten atoms ejected from the filament combine to make a variety of tungsten–iodine compounds that decompose at the hot filament, replenishing it with tungsten atoms. A gas discharge lamp is a common source of ultraviolet and visible radiation. In a xenon discharge lamp, an electrical discharge excites xenon atoms to excited states, which then emit ultraviolet radiation. At pressures exceeding 1 kPa, the output consists of sharp lines on a broad, intense background due to emission from a mixture of ions formed by the electrical discharge. These high-pressure xenon lamps have emission profiles similar to that of a black body heated to 6000 K. In a deuterium lamp, excited D2 molecules dissociate into electronically excited D atoms, which emit intense radiation between 200–400 nm. For certain applications, synchrotron radiation is generated in a synchrotron storage ring, which consists of an electron beam travelling in a circular path with circumferences of up to several hunderd metres. As electrons travelling in a circle are constantly accelerated by the forces that constrain them to their path, they generate radiation (Fig. 13.52). Synchrotron radiation spans a wide range of frequencies, FURTHER INFORMATION 471 observed for different wavelengths when d is similar to the wavelength of radiation being analysed. Wide angular separation results in wide spatial separation between wavelengths some distance away from the grating, where a detector is placed. In a monochromator, a narrow exit slit allows only a narrow range of wavelengths to reach the detector (Fig. 13.54). Turning the grating around an axis perpendicular to the incident and diffracted beams allows different wavelengths to be analysed; in this way, the absorption spectrum is built up one narrow wavelength range at a time. Typically, the grating is swept through an angle that investigates only the first order of diffraction (n = 1). In a polychromator, there is no slit and a broad range of wavelengths can be analysed simultaneously by array detectors, such as those discussed below. Fourier transform techniques In a Fourier transform instrument, the diffraction grating is replaced by a Michelson interferometer, which works by splitting the beam from the sample into two and introducing a varying path difference, p, into one of them (Fig. 13.55). When the two components Linear accelerator Booster synchrotron Storage ring 10 m 30 m Experimental stations Radiation Electron beam Fig. 13.52 A synchrotron storage ring. The electrons injected into the ring from the linear accelerator and booster synchrotron are accelerated to high speed in the main ring. An electron in a curved path is subject to constant acceleration, and an accelerated charge radiates electromagnetic energy. q f Incident beam Scattered beam Diffraction grating Fig. 13.53 One common dispersing element is a diffraction grating, which separates wavelengths spatially as a result of the scattering of light by fine grooves cut into a coated piece of glass. When a polychromatic light beam strikes the surface at an angle θ, several light beams of different wavelengths emerge at different angles φ (eqn 13.71). including the infrared and X-rays. Except in the microwave region, synchrotron radiation is much more intense than can be obtained by most conventional sources. The dispersing element The dispersing element in most absorption spectrometers operating in the ultraviolet to near-infrared region of the spectrum is a diffraction grating, which consists of a glass or ceramic plate into which fine grooves have been cut and covered with a reflective aluminium coating. The grating causes interference between waves reflected from its surface, and constructive interference occurs when nλ = d(sin θ − sin φ) (13.71) where n = 1, 2, . . . is the diffraction order, λ is the wavelength of the diffracted radiation, d is the distance between grooves, θ is the angle of incidence of the beam, and φ is the angle of emergence of the beam (Fig. 13.53). For given values of n and θ, larger differences in φ are Incident beam 1 2 3 Slit To detector Diffraction grating l l l Fig. 13.54 A polychromatic beam is dispersed by a diffraction grating into three component wavelengths λ1, λ2, and λ3. In the configuration shown, only radiation with λ2 passes through a narrow slit and reaches the detector. Rotating the diffraction grating as shown by the double arrows allows λ1 or λ3 to reach the detector. Beam splitter Compensator Mirror, M2 Movable mirror, M1 Fig. 13.55 A Michelson interferometer. The beam-splitting element divides the incident beam into two beams with a path difference that depends on the location of the mirror M1. The compensator ensures that both beams pass through the same thickness of material. 472 13 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 1: ROTATIONAL AND VIBRATIONAL SPECTRA recombine, there is a phase difference between them, and they interfere either constructively or destructively depending on the difference in path lengths. The detected signal oscillates as the two components alternately come into and out of phase as the path difference is changed (Fig. 13.56). If the radiation has wavenumber #, the intensity of the detected signal due to radiation in the range of wavenumbers # to # + d#, which we denote I(p,#)d#, varies with p as I(p,#)d# = I(#)(1 + cos 2π#p)d# (13.72) Hence, the interferometer converts the presence of a particular wavenumber component in the signal into a variation in intensity of the radiation reaching the detector. An actual signal consists of radiation spanning a large number of wavenumbers, and the total intensity at the detector, which we write I(p), is the sum of contributions from all the wavenumbers present in the signal (Fig. 13.57): I(p) = Ύ0 ∞ I(p,#)d# = Ύ0 ∞ I(#)(1 + cos 2π#p)d# (13.73) The problem is to find I(#), the variation of intensity with wavenumber, which is the spectrum we require, from the record of values of I(p). This step is a standard technique of mathematics, and is the ‘Fourier transformation’ step from which this form of spectroscopy takes its name. Specifically: 1 2 30 p~ Intensity,I 4 n Fig. 13.56 An interferogram produced as the path length p is changed in the interferometer shown in Fig. 13.55. Only a single frequency component is present in the signal, so the graph is a plot of the function I(p) = I0(1 + cos 2π#p), where I0 is the intensity of the radiation. Exploration Referring to Fig. 13.55, the mirror M1 moves in finite distance increments, so the path difference p is also incremented in finite steps. Explore the effect of increasing the step size on the shape of the interferogram for a monochromatic beam of wavenumber # and intensity I0. That is, draw plots of I(p)/I0 against #p, each with a different number of data points spanning the same total distance path taken by the movable mirror M1. 1 2 30 p~ Intensity,I 4 n Fig. 13.57 An interferogram obtained when several (in this case, three) frequencies are present in the radiation. Exploration For a signal consisting of only a few monochromatic beams, the integral in eqn 13.73 can be replaced by a sum over the finite number of wavenumbers. Use this information to draw your own version of Fig. 13.57. Then, go on to explore the effect of varying the wavenumbers and intensities of the three components of the radiation on the shape of the interferogram. Intensity,()I~ Wavenumber, ~n n Fig. 13.58 The three frequency components and their intensities that account for the appearance of the interferogram in Fig. 13.57. This spectrum is the Fourier transform of the interferogram, and is a depiction of the contributing frequencies. Exploration Calculate the Fourier transforms of the functions you generated in the previous Exploration. I(#) = 4Ύ0 ∞ {I(p) − 1 –2I(0)} cos 2π#pdp (13.74) where I(0) is given by eqn 13.73 with p = 0. This integration is carried out numerically in a computer connected to the spectrometer, and the output, I(#), is the transmission spectrum of the sample (Fig. 13.58). FURTHER INFORMATION 473 A major advantage of the Fourier transform procedure is that all the radiation emitted by the source is monitored continuously. This is in contrast to a spectrometer in which a monochromator discards most of the generated radiation. As a result, Fourier transform spectrometers have a higher sensitivity than conventional spectrometers. Detectors A detector is a device that converts radiation into an electric current or voltage for appropriate signal processing and display. Detectors may consist of a single radiation sensing element or of several small elements arranged in one or two-dimensional arrays. A microwave detector is typically a crystal diode consisting of a tungsten tip in contact with a semiconductor. The most common detectors found in commercial infrared spectrometers are sensitive in the mid-infrared region. In a photovoltaic device the potential difference changes upon exposure to infrared radiation. In a pyroelectric device the capacitance is sensitive to temperature and hence the presence of infrared radiation. A common detector for work in the ultraviolet and visible ranges is the photomultiplier tube (PMT), in which the photoelectric effect (Section 8.2a) is used to generate an electrical signal proportional to the intensity of light that strikes the detector. In a PMT, photons first strike the photocathode, usually a metallic surface to which a large negative potential is applied. Each electron ejected from the photocathode is accelerated by a potential difference to another metallic surface, called the dynode, from which more electrons are ejected. After travelling through a chain of dynodes, with each dynode at a more positive potential than the preceding dynode in the chain, all the ejected electrons are collected at a final metallic surface called the anode. Depending on how the detector is constructed, a PMT can produce up to 108 electrons per photon that strikes the photocathode. This sensitivity is important for the detection of light from weak sources, but can pose problems as well. At room temperature, a small number of electrons on the surfaces of the photocathode and dynodes have sufficient energy to be ejected even in the dark. When amplified through the dynode chain, these electrons give rise to a dark current, which interferes with measurements on the sample of interest. To minimize the dark current, it is common to lower the temperature of the PMT detector. A common, but less sensitive, alternative to the PMT is the photodiode, a solid-state device that conducts electricity when struck by photons because light-induced electron transfer reactions in the detector material create mobile charge carriers (negatively charged electrons and positively charged ‘holes’). In an avalanche photodiode, the photo-generated electrons are accelerated through a very large electrical potential difference. The high-energy electrons then collide with other atoms in the solid and ionize them, thus creating an avalanche of secondary charge carriers and increasing the sensitivity of the device toward photons. The charge-coupled device (CCD) is a two-dimensional array of several million small photodiode detectors. With a CCD, a wide range of wavelengths that emerge from a polychromator are detected simultaneously, thus eliminating the need to measure light intensity one narrow wavelength range at a time. CCD detectors are the imaging devices in digital cameras, but are also used widely in spectroscopy to measure absorption, emission, and Raman scattering. In Raman microscopy, a CCD detector can be used in a variation of the technique known as Raman imaging: a special optical filter allows only one Stokes line to reach the two-dimensional detector, which then contains a map of the distribution of the intensity of that line in the illuminated area. Resolution A number of factors determine a spectrometer’s resolution, the smallest observable separation between two closely spaced spectral bands. We have already seen that the ability of a diffraction grating to disperse light depends on the distance between the grating’s grooves and on the wavelength of the incident radiation. Furthermore, the distance between the grating and the slit placed in front of a detector must be long enough and the slit’s width must be narrow enough so full advantage can be taken of the grating’s dispersing ability (Fig. 13.54). It follows that a bad choice of grating, slit width, and detector placement may result in the failure to distinguish between closely spaced lines or to measure the actual linewidth of any one band in the spectrum. The resolution of Fourier transform spectrometers is determined by the maximum path length difference, pmax, of the interferometer: ∆# = (13.75) To achieve a resolution of 0.1 cm−1 requires a maximum path length difference of 5 cm. Assuming that all instrumental factors have been optimized, the highest resolution is obtained when the sample is gaseous and at such low pressure that collisions between the molecules are infrequent (see Section 13.3b). In liquids and solids, the actual linewidths can be so broad that the sample itself can limit the resolution. Further information 13.2 Selection rules for rotational and vibrational spectroscopy Here we derive the gross and specific selection rules for microwave, infrared, and rotational and vibrational Raman spectroscopy. The starting point for our discussion is the total wavefunction for a molecule, which can be written as ψtotal = ψc.m.ψ where ψc.m. describes the motion of the centre of mass and ψ describes the internal motion of the molecule. If we neglect the effect of electron spin, the Born–Oppenheimer approximation allows us to write ψ as the product of an electronic part, |ε͘, a vibrational part, |v͘, and a rotational part, which for a diatomic molecule can be represented by the spherical harmonics YJ,MJ (θ,φ) (Section 9.7). To simplify the form of the integrals that will soon follow, we are using the Dirac bracket notation introduced in Further information 9.1. The transition dipole moment for a spectroscopic transition can now be written as: µfi = ͗εfvfYJ,f,MJ,f|¢|εiviYJ,i,MJ,i͘ (13.76) and our task is to explore conditions for which this integral vanishes or has a non-zero value. 1 2pmax 474 13 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 1: ROTATIONAL AND VIBRATIONAL SPECTRA Microwave spectra During a pure rotational transition the molecule does not change electronic or vibrational states, so that ͗εfvf| = ͗εivi| = ͗εv| and we identify µεv = ͗εv|¢|εv͘ with the permanent electric dipole moment of the molecule in the state εv. Equation 13.76 becomes µfi = ͗YJ,f,MJ,f |¢εv|YJ,i,MJ,i ͘ The electric dipole moment has components µεv,x, µεv,y, and µεv,z, which, in spherical polar coordinates, are written in terms of µ0, the magnitude of the vector, and the angles θ and φ as µεv,x = µ0 sin θ cos φ µεv,y = µ0 sin θ sin φ µεv,z = µ0 cos θ Here, we have taken the z-axis to be coincident with the figure axis. The transition dipole moment has three components, given by: µfi,x = µ0͗YJ,f,MJ,f |sin θ cos φ|YJ,i,MJ,i ͘ µfi,y = µ0͗YJ,f,MJ,f |sin θ sin φ|YJ,i,MJ,i ͘ µfi,z = µ0͗YJ,f,MJ,f |cos θ|YJ,i,MJ,i ͘ We see immediately that the molecule must have a permanent dipole moment in order to have a microwave spectrum. This is the gross selection rule for microwave spectroscopy. For the specific selection rules we need to examine the conditions for which the integrals do not vanish, and we must consider each component. For the z-component, we simplify the integral by using cos θ ∝ Y1,0 (Table 9.3). It follows that µfi,z ∝ ͗YJ,f,MJ,f |Y1,0|YJ,i,MJ,i ͘ According to the properties of the spherical harmonics (Comment 13.8), this integral vanishes unless Jf − Ji = ±1 and MJ,f − MJ,i = 0. These are two of the selection rules stated in eqn 13.35. Comment 13.8 An important ‘triple integral’ involving the spherical harmonics is Ύ0 π Ύ0 2π Yl″,ml″(θ,φ)*Yl′,m′l (θ,φ)Yl,ml (θ,φ)sinθ dθ dφ = 0 unless ml″ = ml′ + ml and lines of length l″, l′, and l can form a triangle. For the x- and y-components, we use cos φ = 1 –2(eiφ + e−iφ ) and sin φ = −1 –2i(eiφ − e−iφ ) to write sin θ cos φ ∝ Y1,1 + Y1,−1 and sin θ sin φ ∝ Y1,1 − Y1,−1. It follows that µfi,x ∝ ͗YJ,f,MJ,f |(Y1,1 + Y1,−1)|YJ,i,MJ,i ͘ µfi,y ∝ ͗YJ,f,MJ,f |(Y1,1 − Y1,−1)|YJ,i,MJ,i ͘ According to the properties of the spherical harmonics, these integrals vanish unless Jf − Ji = ±1 and MJ,f − MJ,i = ±1. This completes the selection rules of eqn 13.35. Rotational Raman spectra We understand the origin of the gross and specific selection rules for rotational Raman spectroscopy by using a diatomic molecule as an example. The incident electric field of a wave of electromagnetic radiation of frequency ωi induces a molecular dipole moment that is given by µind = αE(t) = αE cos ωit If the molecule is rotating at a circular frequency ωR, to an external observer its polarizability is also time dependent (if it is anisotropic), and we can write α = α0 + ∆α cos 2ωRt where ∆α = α|| − α⊥ and α ranges from α0 + ∆α to α0 − ∆α as the molecule rotates. The 2 appears because the polarizability returns to its initial value twice each revolution (Fig. 13.59). Substituting this expression into the expression for the induced dipole moment gives µind = (α0 + ∆α cos 2ωRt) × (E cos ωit) = α0E cos ωit + E∆α cos 2ωRt cos ωit = α0E cos ωit + 1 –2E∆α{cos(ωi + 2ωR)t + cos(ωi − 2ωR)t} This calculation shows that the induced dipole has a component oscillating at the incident frequency (which generates Rayleigh radiation), and that it also has two components at ωi ± 2ωR, which give rise to the shifted Raman lines. These lines appear only if ∆α ≠ 0; hence the polarizability must be anisotropic for there to be Raman lines. This is the gross selection rule for rotational Raman spectroscopy. We also see that the distortion induced in the molecule by the incident electric field returns to its initial value after a rotation of 180° (that is, twice a revolution). This is the origin of the specific selection rule ∆J = ±2. We now use a quantum mechanical formalism to understand the selection rules. First, we write the x-, y-, and z-components of the induced dipole moment as µind,x = µx sin θ cos φ µind,y = µy sin θ sin φ µind,z = µz cos θ where µx, µy, and µz are the components of the electric dipole moment of the molecule and the z-axis is coincident with the molecular figure axis. The incident electric field also has components along the x-, y-, and z-axes: Ex = E sin θ cos φ Ey = E sin θ sin φ Ez = E cos θ Using eqn 13.40 and the preceding equations, it follows that µind = α⊥Ex sin θ cos φ + α⊥Ey sin θ sin φ + α||E cos θ = α⊥E sin2 θ + α||E cos2 θ By using the spherical harmonic Y2,0(θ,φ) = (5/16π)1/2 (3 cos2 θ − 1) and the relation sin2 θ = 1 − cos2 θ, it follows that: µind = 1 –3α|| + 2 –3α⊥ + 4 –3 1/2 ∆αY2,0(θ,φ) E For a transition between two rotational states, we calculate the integral ͗YJ,f,MJ,f |µind|YJ,i,MJ,i ͘, which has two components: (1 –3α|| + 2 –3α⊥)͗YJf,MJ,f |(YJi,MJ,i ͘ and E∆α͗YJf,MJ,f |Y2,0YJi,MJ,i ͘ According to the properties of the spherical harmonics (Table 9.3), the first integral vanishes unless Jf − Ji = 0 and the second integral vanishes unless Jf − Ji = ±2 and ∆α ≠ 0. These are the gross and specific selection rules for linear rotors. Infrared spectra The gross selection rule for infrared spectroscopy is based on an analysis of the transition dipole moment ͗vf|¢|vi͘, which arises from eqn 13.76 when the molecule does not change electronic or rotational 5 6 7 D E F π 5 A B C 1 2 3 FURTHER INFORMATION 475 states. For simplicity, we shall consider a one-dimensional oscillator (like a diatomic molecule). The electric dipole moment operator depends on the location of all the electrons and all the nuclei in the molecule, so it varies as the internuclear separation changes (Fig. 13.60). If we think of the dipole moment as arising from two partial charges ±δq separated by a distance R = Re + x, we can write its variation with displacement from the equilibrium separation, x, as µ = Rδq = Reδq + xδq = µ0 + xδq where µ0 is the electric dipole moment operator when the nuclei have their equilibrium separation. It then follows that, with f ≠ i, ͗vf|N|vi͘ = µ0͗vf|vi͘ + δq͗vf|x|vi͘ The term proportional to µ0 is zero because the states with different values of v are orthogonal. It follows that the transition dipole moment is ͗vf|N|vi͘ = ͗vf|x|vi ͘δq Because δq = we can write the transition dipole moment more generally as ͗vf|N|vi͘ = ͗vf|x|vi͘ and we see that the right-hand side is zero unless the dipole moment varies with displacement. This is the gross selection rule for infrared spectroscopy. The specific selection rule is determined by considering the value of ͗vf|x|vi ͘. We need to write out the wavefunctions in terms of the Hermite polynomials given in Section 9.5 and then to use their properties (Example 9.4 should be reviewed, for it gives further details of the calculation). We note that x = αy with α = ($2 /meffk)1/4 (eqn 9.28; note that in this context α is not the polarizability). Then we write ͗vf|x|vi͘ = Nvf NviΎ ∞ −∞ Hvf xHvi e−y2 dx = α2 Nvf NviΎ ∞ −∞ Hvf yHvi e−y2 dy D E F dµ dx A B C dµ dx E E E E E 0 90° 180° 270° 360° ^ ^ ^ || || a a a a a Fig. 13.59 The distortion induced in a molecule by an applied electric field returns to its initial value after a rotation of only 180° (that is, twice a revolution). This is the origin of the ∆J = ±2 selection rule in rotational Raman spectroscopy. Electricdipolemoment, Extension, x 0 Linear approximation Actual m Fig. 13.60 The electric dipole moment of a heteronuclear diatomic molecule varies as shown by the purple curve. For small displacements the change in dipole moment is proportional to the displacement. 476 13 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 1: ROTATIONAL AND VIBRATIONAL SPECTRA To evaluate the integral we use the recursion relation yHv = vHv−1 + 1 –2Hv+1 which turns the matrix element into ͗vf|x|vi͘ = α2 Nvf Nvi viΎ ∞ −∞ Hvf Hvi−1e−y2 dy + 1 –2Ύ ∞ −∞ Hvf Hvi+1e−y2 dy The first integral is zero unless vf = vi − 1 and that the second is zero unless vf = vi + 1. It follows that the transition dipole moment is zero unless ∆v = ±1. Comment 13.9 An important integral involving Hermite polynomials is Ύ ∞ −∞ Hv′Hve−y2 dy= 0 if v′ ≠ v π1/2 2v v! if v′ = v Vibrational Raman spectra The gross selection rule for vibrational Raman spectroscopy is based on an analysis of the transition dipole moment ͗εvf| ¢|εvi͘, which is written from eqn 13.76 by using the Born–Oppenheimer 1 2 3 5 6 7 1 2 3 approximation and neglecting the effect of rotation and electron spin. For simplicity, we consider a one-dimensional harmonic oscillator (like a diatomic molecule). First, we use eqn 13.40 to write the transition dipole moment as µfi = ͗εvf|N|εvi͘ = ͗εvf|α|εvi͘E = ͗vf|α(x)|vi͘E where α(x) = ͗ε|α|ε͘ is the polarizability of the molecule, which we expect to be a function of small displacements x from the equilibrium bond length of the molecule (Section 13.13). Next, we expand α(x) as a Taylor series, so the transition dipole moment becomes µfi = vf α(0) + 0 x + · · · vi E = ͗vf|vi͘α(0)E + 0 ͗vf|x|vi͘E + · · · The term containing ͗vf|vi͘ vanishes for f ≠ i because the harmonic oscillator wavefunctions are orthogonal. Therefore, the vibration is Raman active if (dα/dx)0 ≠ 0 and ͗vf|x|vi͘ ≠ 0. Therefore, the polarizability of the molecule must change during the vibration; this is the gross selection rule of Raman spectroscopy. Also, we already know that ͗vf|x|vi͘ ≠ 0 if vf − vi = ±1; this is the specific selection rule of Raman spectroscopy. D E F dα dx A B C D E F dα dx A B C Discussion questions 13.1 Describe the physical origins of linewidths in the absorption and emission spectra of gases, liquids, and solids. 13.2 Discuss the physical origins of the gross selection rules for microwave and infrared spectroscopy. 13.3 Discuss the physical origins of the gross selection rules for rotational and vibrational Raman spectroscopy. 13.4 Consider a diatomic molecule that is highly susceptible to centrifugal distortion in its ground vibrational state. Do you expect excitation to high rotational energy levels to change the equilibrium bond length of this molecule? Justify your answer. 13.5 Suppose that you wish to characterize the normal modes of benzene in the gas phase. Why is it important to obtain both infrared absorption and Raman spectra of your sample? Exercises 13.1a Calculate the ratio of the Einstein coefficients of spontaneous and stimulated emission, A and B, for transitions with the following characteristics: (a) 70.8 pm X-rays, (b) 500 nm visible light, (c) 3000 cm−1 infrared radiation. 13.1b Calculate the ratio of the Einstein coefficients of spontaneous and stimulated emission, A and B, for transitions with the following characteristics: (a) 500 MHz radiofrequency radiation, (e) 3.0 cm microwave radiation. 13.2a What is the Doppler-shifted wavelength of a red (660 nm) traffic light approached at 80 km h−1 ? 13.2b At what speed of approach would a red (660 nm) traffic light appear green (520 nm)? 13.3a Estimate the lifetime of a state that gives rise to a line of width (a) 0.10 cm−1 , (b) 1.0 cm−1 . 13.3b Estimate the lifetime of a state that gives rise to a line of width (a) 100 MHZ, (b) 2.14 cm−1 . 13.4a A molecule in a liquid undergoes about 1.0 × 1013 collisions in each second. Suppose that (a) every collision is effective in deactivating the molecule vibrationally and (b) that one collision in 100 is effective. Calculate the width (in cm−1 ) of vibrational transitions in the molecule. 13.4b A molecule in a gas undergoes about 1.0 × 109 collisions in each second. Suppose that (a) every collision is effective in deactivating the molecule rotationally and (b) that one collision in 10 is effective. Calculate the width (in hertz) of rotational transitions in the molecule. 13.5a Calculate the frequency of the J = 4 ← 3 transition in the pure rotational spectrum of 14 N16 O. The equilibrium bond length is 115 pm. 13.5b Calculate the frequency of the J = 3 ← 2 transition in the pure rotational spectrum of 12 C16 O. The equilibrium bond length is 112.81 pm. 13.6a If the wavenumber of the J = 3 ← 2 rotational transition of 1 H35 Cl considered as a rigid rotator is 63.56 cm−1 , what is (a) the moment of inertia of the molecule, (b) the bond length? 13.6b If the wavenumber of the J = 1 ← 0 rotational transition of 1 H81 Br considered as a rigid rotator is 16.93 cm−1 , what is (a) the moment of inertia of the molecule, (b) the bond length? EXERCISES 477 13.7a Given that the spacing of lines in the microwave spectrum of 27 Al1 H is constant at 12.604 cm−1 , calculate the moment of inertia and bond length of the molecule (m(27 Al) = 26.9815 u). 13.7b Given that the spacing of lines in the microwave spectrum of 35 Cl19 F is constant at 1.033 cm−1 , calculate the moment of inertia and bond length of the molecule (m(35 Cl) = 34.9688 u, m(19 F) = 18.9984 u). 13.8a The rotational constant of 127 I35 Cl is 0.1142 cm−1 . Calculate the ICl bond length (m(35 Cl) = 34.9688 u, m(127 I) = 126.9045 u). 13.8b The rotational constant of 12 C16 O2 is 0.39021 cm−1 . Calculate the bond length of the molecule (m(12 C) = 12 u exactly, m(16 O) = 15.9949 u). 13.9a Determine the HC and CN bond lengths in HCN from the rotational constants B(1 H12 C14 N) = 44.316 GHz and B(2 H12 C14 N) = 36.208 GHz. 13.9b Determine the CO and CS bond lengths in OCS from the rotational constants B(16 O12 C32 S) = 6081.5 MHz, B(16 O12 C34 S) = 5932.8 MHz. 13.10a The wavenumber of the incident radiation in a Raman spectrometer is 20 487 cm−1 . What is the wavenumber of the scattered Stokes radiation for the J = 2 ← 0 transition of 14 N2? 13.10b The wavenumber of the incident radiation in a Raman spectrometer is 20 623 cm−1 . What is the wavenumber of the scattered Stokes radiation for the J = 4 ← 2 transition of 16 O2? 13.11a The rotational Raman spectrum of 35 Cl2 (m(35 Cl) = 34.9688 u) shows a series of Stokes lines separated by 0.9752 cm−1 and a similar series of antiStokes lines. Calculate the bond length of the molecule. 13.11b The rotational Raman spectrum of 19 F2 (m(19 F) = 18.9984 u) shows a series of Stokes lines separated by 3.5312 cm−1 and a similar series of antiStokes lines. Calculate the bond length of the molecule. 13.12a Which of the following molecules may show a pure rotational microwave absorption spectrum: (a) H2, (b) HCl, (c) CH4, (d) CH3Cl, (e) CH2Cl2? 13.12b Which of the following molecules may show a pure rotational microwave absorption spectrum: (a) H2O, (b) H2O2, (c) NH3, (d) N2O? 13.13a Which of the following molecules may show a pure rotational Raman spectrum: (a) H2, (b) HCl, (c) CH4, (d) CH3Cl? 13.13b Which of the following molecules may show a pure rotational Raman spectrum: (a) CH2Cl2, (b) CH3CH3, (c) SF6, (d) N2O? 13.14a An object of mass 1.0 kg suspended from the end of a rubber band has a vibrational frequency of 2.0 Hz. Calculate the force constant of the rubber band. 13.14b An object of mass 2.0 g suspended from the end of a spring has a vibrational frequency of 3.0 Hz. Calculate the force constant of the spring. 13.15a Calculate the percentage difference in the fundamental vibration wavenumber of 23 Na35 Cl and 23 Na37 Cl on the assumption that their force constants are the same. 13.15b Calculate the percentage difference in the fundamental vibration wavenumber of 1 H35 Cl and 2 H37 Cl on the assumption that their force constants are the same. 13.16a The wavenumber of the fundamental vibrational transition of 35 Cl2 is 564.9 cm−1 . Calculate the force constant of the bond (m(35 Cl) = 34.9688 u). 13.16b The wavenumber of the fundamental vibrational transition of 79 Br81 Br is 323.2 cm−1 . Calculate the force constant of the bond (m(79 Br) = 78.9183 u, m(81 Br) = 80.9163 u). 13.17a Calculate the relative numbers of Cl2 molecules (# = 559.7 cm−1 ) in the ground and first excited vibrational states at (a) 298 K, (b) 500 K. 13.17b Calculate the relative numbers of Br2 molecules (# = 321 cm−1 ) in the second and first excited vibrational states at (a) 298 K, (b) 800 K. 13.18a The hydrogen halides have the following fundamental vibrational wavenumbers: 4141.3 cm−1 (HF); 2988.9 cm−1 (H35 Cl); 2649.7 cm−1 (H81 Br); 2309.5 cm−1 (H127 I). Calculate the force constants of the hydrogen–halogen bonds. 13.18b From the data in Exercise 13.18a, predict the fundamental vibrational wavenumbers of the deuterium halides. 13.19a For 16 O2, ∆G values for the transitions v = 1 ← 0, 2 ← 0, and 3 ← 0 are, respectively, 1556.22, 3088.28, and 4596.21 cm−1 . Calculate # and xe. Assume ye to be zero. 13.19b For 14 N2, ∆G values for the transitions v = 1 ← 0, 2 ← 0, and 3 ← 0 are, respectively, 2345.15, 4661.40, and 6983.73 cm−1 . Calculate # and xe. Assume ye to be zero. 13.20a The first five vibrational energy levels of HCl are at 1481.86, 4367.50, 7149.04, 9826.48, and 12 399.8 cm−1 . Calculate the dissociation energy of the molecule in reciprocal centimetres and electronvolts. 13.20b The first five vibrational energy levels of HI are at 1144.83, 3374.90, 5525.51, 7596.66, and 9588.35 cm−1 . Calculate the dissociation energy of the molecule in reciprocal centimetres and electronvolts. 13.21a Infrared absorption by 1 H81 Br gives rise to an R branch from v = 0. What is the wavenumber of the line originating from the rotational state with J = 2? Use the information in Table 13.2. 13.21b Infrared absorption by 1 H127 I gives rise to an R branch from v = 0. What is the wavenumber of the line originating from the rotational state with J = 2? Use the information in Table 13.2. 13.22a Which of the following molecules may show infrared absorption spectra: (a) H2, (b) HCl, (c) CO2, (d) H2O? 13.22b Which of the following molecules may show infrared absorption spectra: (a) CH3CH3, (b) CH4, (c) CH3Cl, (d) N2? 13.23a How many normal modes of vibration are there for the following molecules: (a) H2O, (b) H2O2, (c) C2H4? 13.23b How many normal modes of vibration are there for the following molecules: (a) C6H6, (b) C6H6CH3, (c) HC.C-C.CH. 13.24a Which of the three vibrations of an AB2 molecule are infrared or Raman active when it is (a) angular, (b) linear? 13.24b Which of the vibrations of an AB3 molecule are infrared or Raman active when it is (a) trigonal planar, (b) trigonal pyramidal? 13.25a Consider the vibrational mode that corresponds to the uniform expansion of the benzene ring. Is it (a) Raman, (b) infrared active? 13.25b Consider the vibrational mode that corresponds to the boat-like bending of a benzene ring. Is it (a) Raman, (b) infrared active? 13.26a The molecule CH2Cl2 belongs to the point group C2v. The displacements of the atoms span 5A1 + 2A2 + 4B1 + 4B2. What are the symmetries of the normal modes of vibration? 13.26b A carbon disulfide molecule belongs to the point group D∞h. The nine displacements of the three atoms span A1g + A1u + A2g + 2E1u + E1g. What are the symmetries of the normal modes of vibration? 478 13 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 1: ROTATIONAL AND VIBRATIONAL SPECTRA Problems* Numerical problems 13.1 Use mathematical software to evaluate the Planck distribution at any temperature and wavelength or frequency, and evaluate integrals for the energy density of the radiation between any two wavelengths. Calculate the total energy density in the visible region (700 nm to 400 nm) for a black body at (a) 1500 K, a typical operating temperature for globars, (b) 2500 K, a typical operating temperature for tungsten filament lamps, (c) 5800 K, the surface temperature of the Sun. What are the classical values at these temperatures? 13.2 Calculate the Doppler width (as a fraction of the transition wavelength) for any kind of transition in (a) HCl, (b) ICl at 25°C. What would be the widths of the rotational and vibrational transitions in these molecules (in MHz and cm−1 , respectively), given B(ICl) = 0.1142 cm−1 and #(ICl) = 384 cm−1 and additional information in Table 13.2. 13.3 The collision frequency z of a molecule of mass m in a gas at a pressure p is z = 4σ(kT/πm)1/2 p/kT, where σ is the collision cross-section. Find an expression for the collision-limited lifetime of an excited state assuming that every collision is effective. Estimate the width of rotational transition in HCl (σ = 0.30 nm2 ) at 25°C and 1.0 atm. To what value must the pressure of the gas be reduced in order to ensure that collision broadening is less important than Doppler broadening? 13.4 The rotational constant of NH3 is equivalent to 298 GHz. Compute the separation of the pure rotational spectrum lines in GHz, cm−1 , and mm, and show that the value of B is consistent with an N-H bond length of 101.4 pm and a bond angle of 106.78°. 13.5 The rotational constant for CO is 1.9314 cm−1 and 1.6116 cm−1 in the ground and first excited vibrational states, respectively. By how much does the internuclear distance change as a result of this transition? 13.6 Pure rotational Raman spectra of gaseous C6H6 and C6D6 yield the following rotational constants: B(C6H6) = 0.189 60 cm−1 , B(C6D6) = 0.156 81 cm−1 . The moments of inertia of the molecules about any axis perpendicular to the C6 axis were calculated from these data as I(C6H6) = 1.4759 × 10−45 kg m2 , I(C6D6) = 1.7845 × 10−45 kg m2 . Calculate the CC, CH, and CD bond lengths. 13.7 Rotational absorption lines from 1 H35 Cl gas were found at the following wavenumbers (R.L. Hausler and R.A. Oetjen, J. Chem. Phys. 21, 1340 (1953)): 83.32, 104.13, 124.73, 145.37, 165.89, 186.23, 206.60, 226.86 cm−1 . Calculate the moment of inertia and the bond length of the molecule. Predict the positions of the corresponding lines in 2 H35 Cl. 13.8 Is the bond length in HCl the same as that in DCl? The wavenumbers of the J = 1 ← 0 rotational transitions for H35 Cl and 2 H35 Cl are 20.8784 and 10.7840 cm−1 , respectively. Accurate atomic masses are 1.007825 u and 2.0140 u for 1 H and 2 H, respectively. The mass of 35 Cl is 34.96885 u. Based on this information alone, can you conclude that the bond lengths are the same or different in the two molecules? 13.9 Thermodynamic considerations suggest that the copper monohalides CuX should exist mainly as polymers in the gas phase, and indeed it proved difficult to obtain the monomers in sufficient abundance to detect spectroscopically. This problem was overcome by flowing the halogen gas over copper heated to 1100 K (E.L. Manson, F.C. de Lucia, and W. Gordy, J. Chem. Phys. 63, 2724 (1975)). For CuBr the J = 13–14, 14–15, and 15–16 transitions occurred at 84 421.34, 90 449.25, and 96 476.72 MHz, respectively. Calculate the rotational constant and bond length of CuBr. 13.10 The microwave spectrum of 16 O12 CS (C.H. Townes, A.N. Holden, and F.R. Merritt, Phys. Rev. 74, 1113 (1948)) gave absorption lines (in GHz) as follows: J 1 2 3 4 32 S 24.325 92 36.488 82 48.651 64 60.814 08 34 S 23.732 33 47.462 40 Use the expressions for moments of inertia in Table 13.1 and assume that the bond lengths are unchanged by substitution; calculate the CO and CS bond lengths in OCS. 13.11‡ In a study of the rotational spectrum of the linear FeCO radical, K. Tanaka, M. Shirasaka, and T. Tanaka (J. Chem. Phys. 106, 6820 (1997)) report the following J + 1 ← J transitions: J 24 25 26 27 28 29 #/m−1 214 777.7 223 379.0 231 981.2 240 584.4 249 188.5 257 793.5 Evaluate the rotational constant of the molecule. Also, estimate the value of J for the most highly populated rotational energy level at 298 K and at 100 K. 13.12 The vibrational energy levels of NaI lie at the wavenumbers 142.81, 427.31, 710.31, and 991.81 cm−1 . Show that they fit the expression (v + 1 –2)# − (v + 1 –2)2 x#, and deduce the force constant, zero-point energy, and dissociation energy of the molecule. 13.13 Predict the shape of the nitronium ion, NO2 + , from its Lewis structure and the VSEPR model. It has one Raman active vibrational mode at 1400 cm−1 , two strong IR active modes at 2360 and 540 cm−1 , and one weak IR mode at 3735 cm−1 . Are these data consistent with the predicted shape of the molecule? Assign the vibrational wavenumbers to the modes from which they arise. 13.14 At low resolution, the strongest absorption band in the infrared absorption spectrum of 12 C16 O is centred at 2150 cm−1 . Upon closer examination at higher resolution, this band is observed to be split into two sets of closely spaced peaks, one on each side of the centre of the spectrum at 2143.26 cm−1 . The separation between the peaks immediately to the right and left of the centre is 7.655 cm−1 . Make the harmonic oscillator and rigid rotor approximations and calculate from these data: (a) the vibrational wavenumber of a CO molecule, (b) its molar zero-point vibrational energy, (c) the force constant of the CO bond, (d) the rotational constant B, and (e) the bond length of CO. 13.15 The HCl molecule is quite well described by the Morse potential with De = 5.33 eV, # = 2989.7 cm−1 , and x# = 52.05 cm−1 . Assuming that the potential is unchanged on deuteration, predict the dissociation energies (D0) of (a) HCl, (b) DCl. 13.16 The Morse potential (eqn 13.54) is very useful as a simple representation of the actual molecular potential energy. When RbH was studied, it was found that # = 936.8 cm−1 and x# = 14.15 cm−1 . Plot the potential energy curve from 50 pm to 800 pm around Re = 236.7 pm. Then go on to explore how the rotation of a molecule may weaken its bond by allowing for the kinetic energy of rotation of a molecule and plotting V* = V + hcBJ(J + 1) with B = $/4πcµR2 . Plot these curves on the same diagram for J = 40, 80, and 100, and observe how the dissociation energy is affected by the * Problems denoted with the symbol ‡ were supplied by Charles Trapp, Carmen Giunta, and Marshall Cady. PROBLEMS 479 rotation. (Taking B = 3.020 cm−1 at the equilibrium bond length will greatly simplify the calculation.) 13.17‡ F. Luo, G.C. McBane, G. Kim, C.F. Giese, and W.R. Gentry (J. Chem. Phys. 98, 3564 (1993)) reported experimental observation of the He2 complex, a species that had escaped detection for a long time. The fact that the observation required temperatures in the neighbourhood of 1 mK is consistent with computational studies that suggest that hcDe for He2 is about 1.51 × 10−23 J, hcD0 about 2 × 10−26 J, and Re about 297 pm. (a) Estimate the fundamental vibrational wavenumber, force constant, moment of inertia, and rotational constant based on the harmonic oscillator and rigid-rotor approximations. (b) Such a weakly bound complex is hardly likely to be rigid. Estimate the vibrational wavenumber and anharmonicity constant based on the Morse potential. 13.18 As mentioned in Section 13.15, the semi-empirical, ab initio, and DFT methods discussed in Chapter 11 can be used to estimate the force field of a molecule. The molecule’s vibrational spectrum can be simulated, and it is then possible to determine the correspondence between a vibrational frequency and the atomic displacements that give rise to a normal mode. (a) Using molecular modelling software3 and the computational method of your choice (semi-empirical, ab initio, or DFT methods), calculate the fundamental vibrational wavenumbers and visualize the vibrational normal modes of SO2 in the gas phase. (b) The experimental values of the fundamental vibrational wavenumbers of SO2 in the gas phase are 525 cm−1 , 1151 cm−1 , and 1336 cm−1 . Compare the calculated and experimental values. Even if agreement is poor, is it possible to establish a correlation between an experimental value of the vibrational wavenumber with a specific vibrational normal mode? 13.19 Consider the molecule CH3Cl. (a) To what point group does the molecule belong? (b) How many normal modes of vibration does the molecule have? (c) What are the symmetries of the normal modes of vibration for this molecule? (d) Which of the vibrational modes of this molecule are infrared active? (e) Which of the vibrational modes of this molecule are Raman active? 13.20 Suppose that three conformations are proposed for the nonlinear molecule H2O2 (2, 3, and 4). The infrared absorption spectrum of gaseous H2O2 has bands at 870, 1370, 2869, and 3417 cm−1 . The Raman spectrum of the same sample has bands at 877, 1408, 1435, and 3407 cm−1 . All bands correspond to fundamental vibrational wavenumbers and you may assume that: (i) the 870 and 877 cm−1 bands arise from the same normal mode, and (ii) the 3417 and 3407 cm−1 bands arise from the same normal mode. (a) If H2O2 were linear, how many normal modes of vibration would it have? (b) Give the symmetry point group of each of the three proposed conformations of nonlinear H2O2. (c) Determine which of the proposed conformations is inconsistent with the spectroscopic data. Explain your reasoning. Theoretical problems 13.21 Show that the moment of inertia of a diatomic molecule composed of atoms of masses mA and mB and bond length R is equal to meffR2 , where meff = mAmB/(mA + mB). 13.22 Derive eqn 13.34 for the centrifugal distortion constant DJ of a diatomic molecule of effective mass meff. Treat the bond as an elastic spring 2 3 4 with force constant k and equilibrium length re that is subjected to a centrifugal distortion to a new length rc. Begin the derivation by letting the particles experience a restoring force of magnitude k(rc − re) that is countered perfectly by a centrifugal force meffω2 rc, where ω is the angular velocity of the rotating molecule. Then introduce quantum mechanical effects by writing the angular momentum as {J(J + 1)}1/2 $. Finally, write an expression for the energy of the rotating molecule, compare it with eqn 13.33, and write an expression for DJ. For help with the classical aspects of this derivation, see Appendix 3. 13.23 In the group theoretical language developed in Chapter 12, a spherical rotor is a molecule that belongs to a cubic or icosahedral point group, a symmetric rotor is a molecule with at least a threefold axis of symmetry, and an asymmetric rotor is a molecule without a threefold (or higher) axis. Linear molecules are linear rotors. Classify each of the following molecules as a spherical, symmetric, linear, or asymmetric rotor and justify your answers with group theoretical arguments: (a) CH4, (b) CH3CN, (c) CO2, (d) CH3OH, (e) benzene, (f) pyridine. 13.24 Derive an expression for the value of J corresponding to the most highly populated rotational energy level of a diatomic rotor at a temperature T remembering that the degeneracy of each level is 2J + 1. Evaluate the expression for ICl (for which B = 0.1142 cm−1 ) at 25°C. Repeat the problem for the most highly populated level of a spherical rotor, taking note of the fact that each level is (2J + 1)2 -fold degenerate. Evaluate the expression for CH4 (for which B = 5.24 cm−1 ) at 25°C. 13.25 The moments of inertia of the linear mercury(II) halides are very large, so the O and S branches of their vibrational Raman spectra show little rotational structure. Nevertheless, the peaks of both branches can be identified and have been used to measure the rotational constants of the molecules (R.J.H. Clark and D.M. Rippon, J. Chem. Soc. Faraday Soc. II, 69, 1496 (1973)). Show, from a knowledge of the value of J corresponding to the intensity maximum, that the separation of the peaks of the O and S branches is given by the Placzek–Teller relation δ# = (32BkT/hc)1/2 . The following widths were obtained at the temperatures stated: HgCl2 HgBr2 HgI2 θ/°C 282 292 292 δ#/cm−1 23.8 15.2 11.4 Calculate the bond lengths in the three molecules. 13.26 Confirm that a Morse oscillator has a finite number of bound states, the states with V < hcDe. Determine the value of νmax for the highest bound state. Applications: to biology, environmental science, and astrophysics 13.27 The protein haemerythrin is responsible for binding and carrying O2 in some invertebrates. Each protein molecule has two Fe2+ ions that are in very close proximity and work together to bind one molecule of O2. The Fe2O2 group of oxygenated haemerythrin is coloured and has an electronic absorption band at 500 nm. The resonance Raman spectrum of oxygenated haemerythrin obtained with laser excitation at 500 nm has a band at 844 cm−1 that has been attributed to the O-O stretching mode of bound 16 O2. (a) Why is resonance Raman spectroscopy and not infrared spectroscopy the method of choice for the study of the binding of O2 to haemerythrin? (b) Proof that the 844 cm−1 band arises from a bound O2 species may be obtained by conducting experiments on samples of haemerythrin that have been mixed with 18 O2, instead of16 O2. Predict the fundamental vibrational wavenumber of the 18 O-18 O stretching mode in a sample of haemerythrin that has been treated with 18 O2. (c) The fundamental vibrational wavenumbers for the 3 The web site contains links to molecular modelling freeware and to other sites where you may perform molecular orbital calculations directly from your web browser. 480 13 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 1: ROTATIONAL AND VIBRATIONAL SPECTRA O-O stretching modes of O2, O2 − (superoxide anion), and O2 2− (peroxide anion) are 1555, 1107, and 878 cm−1 , respectively. Explain this trend in terms of the electronic structures of O2, O2 − , and O2 2− . Hint: Review Section 11.4. What are the bond orders of O2, O2 − , and O2 2− ? (d) Based on the data given above, which of the following species best describes the Fe2O2 group of haemerythrin: Fe2 2+ O2, Fe2+ Fe3+ O2 − , or Fe2 3+ O2 2− ? Explain your reasoning. (e) The resonance Raman spectrum of haemerythrin mixed with 16 O18 O has two bands that can be attributed to the O-O stretching mode of bound oxygen. Discuss how this observation may be used to exclude one or more of the four proposed schemes (5–8) for binding of O2 to the Fe2 site of haemerythrin. 13.28‡ A mixture of carbon dioxide (2.1 per cent) and helium, at 1.00 bar and 298 K in a gas cell of length 10 cm has an infrared absorption band centred at 2349 cm−1 with absorbances, A(#), described by: A(#) = + where the coefficients are a1 = 0.932, a2 = 0.005050 cm2 , a3 = 2333 cm−1 , a4 = 1.504, a5 = 0.01521 cm2 , a6 = 2362 cm−1 . (a) Draw graphs of A(#) and ε(#). What is the origin of both the band and the band width? What are the allowed and forbidden transitions of this band? (b) Calculate the transition wavenumbers and absorbances of the band with a simple harmonic oscillatorrigid rotor model and compare the result with the experimental spectra. The CO bond length is 116.2 pm. (c) Within what height, h, is basically all the infrared emission from the Earth in this band absorbed by atmospheric carbon dioxide? The mole fraction of CO2 in the atmosphere is 3.3 × 10−4 and T/K = 288 −0.0065(h/m) below 10 km. Draw a surface plot of the atmospheric transmittance of the band as a function of both height and wavenumber. 13.29 In Problem 10.27, we saw that Doppler shifts of atomic spectral lines are used to estimate the speed of recession or approach of a star. From the discussion in Section 13.3a, it is easy to see that Doppler broadening of an atomic spectral line depends on the temperature of the star that emits the a4 1 + a5(#− a6)2 a1 1 + a2(#− a3)2 7 8 5 6 radiation. A spectral line of 48 Ti8+ (of mass 47.95 u) in a distant star was found to be shifted from 654.2 nm to 706.5 nm and to be broadened to 61.8 pm. What is the speed of recession and the surface temperature of the star? 13.30 A. Dalgarno, in Chemistry in the interstellar medium, Frontiers of Astrophysics, E.H. Avrett (ed.), Harvard University Press, Cambridge (1976), notes that although both CH and CN spectra show up strongly in the interstellar medium in the constellation Ophiuchus, the CN spectrum has become the standard for the determination of the temperature of the cosmic microwave background radiation. Demonstrate through a calculation why CH would not be as useful for this purpose as CN. The rotational constant B0 for CH is 14.190 cm−1 . 13.31‡ There is a gaseous interstellar cloud in the constellation Ophiuchus that is illuminated from behind by the star ζ-Ophiuci. Analysis of the electronic–vibrational–rotational absorption lines obtained by H.S. Uhler and R.A. Patterson (Astrophys. J. 42, 434 (1915)) shows the presence of CN molecules in the interstellar medium. A strong absorption line in the ultraviolet region at λ = 387.5 nm was observed corresponding to the transition J = 0–1. Unexpectedly, a second strong absorption line with 25 per cent of the intensity of the first was found at a slightly longer wavelength (∆λ = 0.061 nm) corresponding to the transition J = 1–1 (here allowed). Calculate the temperature of the CN molecules. Gerhard Herzberg, who was later to receive the Nobel Prize for his contributions to spectroscopy, calculated the temperature as 2.3 K. Although puzzled by this result, he did not realize its full significance. If he had, his prize might have been for the discovery of the cosmic microwave background radiation. 13.32‡ The H3 + ion has recently been found in the interstellar medium and in the atmospheres of Jupiter, Saturn, and Uranus. The rotational energy levels of H3 + , an oblate symmetric rotor, are given by eqn 13.29, with C replacing A, when centrifugal distortion and other complications are ignored. Experimental values for vibrational–rotational constants are #(E′) = 2521.6 cm−1 , B = 43.55 cm−1 , and C = 20.71 cm−1 . (a) Show that, for a nonlinear planar molecule (such as H3 + ), IC = 2IB. The rather large discrepancy with the experimental values is due to factors ignored in eqn 13.29. (b) Calculate an approximate value of the H-H bond length in H3 + . (c) The value of Re obtained from the best quantum mechanical calculations by J.B. Anderson (J. Chem. Phys. 96, 3702 (1991)) is 87.32 pm. Use this result to calculate the values of the rotational constants B and C. (d) Assuming that the geometry and force constants are the same in D3 + and H3 + , calculate the spectroscopic constants of D3 + . The molecular ion D3 + was first produced by J.T. Shy, J.W. Farley, W.E. Lamb Jr, and W.H. Wing (Phys. Rev. Lett 45, 535 (1980)) who observed the ν2(E′) band in the infrared. 13.33 The space immediately surrounding stars, also called the circumstellar space, is significantly warmer because stars are very intense black-body emitters with temperatures of several thousand kelvin. Discuss how such factors as cloud temperature, particle density, and particle velocity may affect the rotational spectrum of CO in an interstellar cloud. What new features in the spectrum of CO can be observed in gas ejected from and still near a star with temperatures of about 1000 K, relative to gas in a cloud with temperature of about 10 K? Explain how these features may be used to distinguish between circumstellar and interstellar material on the basis of the rotational spectrum of CO. Molecular spectroscopy 2: electronic transitions Simple analytical expressions for the electronic energy levels of molecules cannot be given, so this chapter concentrates on the qualitative features of electronic transitions. A common theme throughout the chapter is that electronic transitions occur within a stationary nuclear framework. We pay particular attention to spontaneous radiative decay processes, which include fluorescence and phosphorescence. A specially important example of stimulated radiative decay is that responsible for the action of lasers, and we see how this stimulated emission may be achieved and employed. The energies needed to change the electron distributions of molecules are of the order of several electronvolts (1 eV is equivalent to about 8000 cm−1 or 100 kJ mol−1 ). Consequently, the photons emitted or absorbed when such changes occur lie in the visible and ultraviolet regions of the spectrum (Table 14.1). One of the revolutions that has occurred in physical chemistry in recent years is the application of lasers to spectroscopy and kinetics. Lasers have brought unprecedented precision to spectroscopy, made Raman spectroscopy a widely useful technique, and have made it possible to study chemical reactions on a femtosecond time scale. We shall see the principles of their action in this chapter and their applications throughout the rest of the book. The characteristics of electronic transitions In the ground state of a molecule the nuclei are at equilibrium in the sense that they experience no net force from the electrons and other nuclei in the molecule. Immediately after an electronic transition they are subjected to different forces and 14 The characteristics of electronic transitions 14.1 The electronic spectra of diatomic molecules 14.2 The electronic spectra of polyatomic molecules I14.1 Impact on biochemistry: Vision The fates of electronically excited states 14.3 Fluorescence and phosphorescence I14.2 Impact on biochemistry: Fluorescence microscopy 14.4 Dissociation and predissociation Lasers 14.5 General principles of laser action 14.6 Applications of lasers in chemistry Checklist of key ideas Further reading Further information 14.1: Examples of practical lasers Discussion questions Exercises Problems Synoptic table 14.1* Colour, frequency, and energy of light Colour λ/nm ν/(1014 Hz) E/(kJ mol−1 ) Infrared >1000 <3.0 <120 Red 700 4.3 170 Yellow 580 5.2 210 Blue 470 6.4 250 Ultraviolet <300 >10 >400 * More values are given in the Data section. 482 14 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 2: ELECTRONIC TRANSITIONS the molecule may respond by starting to vibrate. The resulting vibrational structure of electronic transitions can be resolved for gaseous samples, but in a liquid or solid the lines usually merge together and result in a broad, almost featureless band (Fig. 14.1). Superimposed on the vibrational transitions that accompany the electronic transition of a molecule in the gas phase is an additional branch structure that arises from rotational transitions. The electronic spectra of gaseous samples are therefore very complicated but rich in information. 14.1 The electronic spectra of diatomic molecules We examine some general features of electronic transitions by using diatomic molecules as examples. We begin by assigning term symbols to ground and excited electronic states. Then we use the symmetry designations to formulate selection rules. Finally, we examine the origin of vibrational structure in electronic spectra. (a) Term symbols The term symbols of linear molecules (the analogues of the symbols 2 P, etc. for atoms) are constructed in a similar way to those for atoms, but now we must pay attention to the component of total orbital angular momentum about the internuclear axis, Λ$. The value of |Λ| is denoted by the symbols Σ, Π, ∆, . . . for |Λ| = 0, 1, 2 . . . , respectively. These labels are the analogues of S, P, D, . . . for atoms. The value of Λ is the sum of the values of λ, the quantum number for the component λ$ of orbital angular momentum of an individual electron around the internuclear axis. A single electron in a σ orbital has λ = 0: the orbital is cylindrically symmetrical and has no angular nodes when viewed along the internuclear axis. Therefore, if that is the only electron present, Λ = 0. The term symbol for H2 + is therefore Σ. As in atoms, we use a superscript with the value of 2S + 1 to denote the multiplicity of the term. The component of total spin angular momentum about the internuclear axis is denoted Σ, where Σ = S, S − 1, S − 2, . . . , −S. For H2 + , because there is only one electron, S = s = 1 –2 (Σ = ± 1 –2) and the term symbol is 2 Σ, a doublet term. The overall parity of the term is added as a right subscript. For H2 + , the parity of the only occupied orbital is g (Section 11.3c), so the term itself is also g, and in full dress is 2 Σg. If there are several electrons, the overall parity is calculated by using g × g = g u × u = g u × g = u (14.1) These rules are generated by interpreting g as +1 and u as −1. The term symbol for the ground state of any closed-shell homonuclear diatomic molecule is 1 Σg because the spin is zero (a singlet term in which all electrons paired), there is no orbital angular momentum from a closed shell, and the overall parity is g. A π electron in a diatomic molecule has one unit of orbital angular momentum about the internuclear axis (λ = ±1), and if it is the only electron outside a closed shell, gives rise to a Π term. If there are two π electrons (as in the ground state of O2, with configuration 1πu 4 1πg 2 ) then the term symbol may be either Σ (if the electrons are travelling in opposite directions, which is the case if they occupy different π orbitals, one with λ = +1 and the other with λ = −1) or ∆ (if they are travelling in the same direction, which is the case if they occupy the same π orbital, both λ = +1, for instance). For O2, the two π electrons occupy different orbitals with parallel spins (a triplet term), so the ground term is 3 Σ. The overall parity of the molecule is (closed shell) × g × g = g The term symbol is therefore 3 Σg. 400 500 600 700 /nm Absorbance l Fig. 14.1 The absorption spectrum of chlorophyll in the visible region. Note that it absorbs in the red and blue regions, and that green light is not absorbed. Comment 14.1 It is important to distinguish between the (upright) term symbol Σ and the (sloping) quantum number Σ. 14.1 THE ELECTRONIC SPECTRA OF DIATOMIC MOLECULES 483 For Σ terms, a ± superscript denotes the behaviour of the molecular wavefunction under reflection in a plane containing the nuclei (Fig. 14.2). If, for convenience, we think of O2 as having one electron in 1πg,x, which changes sign under reflection in the yz-plane, and the other electron in 1πg,y, which does not change sign under reflection in the same plane, then the overall reflection symmetry is (closed shell) × (+) × (−) = (−) and the full term symbol of the ground electronic state of O2 is 3 Σg − . The term symbols of excited electronic states are constructed in a similar way. For example, the term symbol for the excited state of O2 formed by placing two electrons in a 1πg,x (or in a 1πg,y) orbital is 1 ∆g because |Λ| = 2 (two electrons in the same π orbital), the spin is zero (all electrons are paired), and the overall parity is (closed shell) × g × g = g. Table 14.2 and Fig. 14.3 summarize the configurations, term symbols, and energies of the ground and some excited states of O2. (b) Selection rules A number of selection rules govern which transitions will be observed in the electronic spectrum of a molecule. The selection rules concerned with changes in angular momentum are ∆Λ = 0, ±1 ∆S = 0 ∆Σ = 0 ∆Ω = 0, ±1 where Ω = Λ + Σ is the quantum number for the component of total angular momentum (orbital and spin) around the internuclear axis (Fig. 14.4). As in atoms (Section 10.9), the origins of these rules are conservation of angular momentum during a transition and the fact that a photon has a spin of 1. There are two selection rules concerned with changes in symmetry. First, for Σ terms, only Σ+ ↔ Σ+ and Σ− ↔ Σ− transitions are allowed. Second, the Laporte selection rule for centrosymmetric molecules (those with a centre of inversion) and atoms states that: The only allowed transitions are transitions that are accompanied by a change of parity. That is, u → g and g → u transitions are allowed, but g → g and u → u transitions are forbidden. + Fig. 14.2 The + or – on a term symbol refers to the overall symmetry of a configuration under reflection in a plane containing the two nuclei. Table 14.2 Properties of O2 in its lower electronic states* Configuration† Term Relative energy/cm−1 #/cm−1 Re/pm πu 2 πu 2 πg 1 πg 1 3 Σg − 0 1580 120.74 πu 2 πu 2 πg 2 πg 0 1 ∆g 7 882.39 1509 121.55 πu 2 πu 2 πg 1 πg 1 1 Σg + 13 120.9 1433 122.68 πu 2 πu 1 πg 2 πg 1 3 Σu + 35 713 819 142 πu 2 πu 1 πg 2 πg 1 3 Σu − 49 363 700 160 * Adapted from G. Herzberg, Spectra of diatomic molecules, Van Nostrand, New York (1950) and D.C. Harris and M.D. Bertolucci, Symmetry and spectroscopy: an introduction to vibrational and electronic spectroscopy, Dover, New York (1989). † The configuration πu 2 πu 1 πg 2 πg 1 should also give rise to a 3 ∆u term, but electronic transitions to or from this state have not been observed. 0 20 40 60 Wavenumber,/(10cm) 31~ 100 200 300 r/pm O( P) O( P)3 3 + O( P) O( D)3 1 + 3 Sg 1 Dg 1 Sg 3 Su 3 Su - + + - n - L S L S W Fig. 14.3 The electronic states of dioxygen. Fig. 14.4 The coupling of spin and orbital angular momenta in a linear molecule: only the components along the internuclear axis are conserved. 484 14 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 2: ELECTRONIC TRANSITIONS Justification 14.1 The Laporte selection rule The last two selection rules result from the fact that the electric-dipole transition moment µfi = Ύψf*Nψi dτ vanishes unless the integrand is invariant under all symmetry operations of the molecule. The three components of the dipole moment operator transform like x, y, and z, and are all u. Therefore, for a g → g transition, the overall parity of the transition dipole moment is g × u × g = u, so it must be zero. Likewise, for a u → u transition, the overall parity is u × u × u = u, so the transition dipole moment must also vanish. Hence, transitions without a change of parity are forbidden. The zcomponent of the dipole moment operator, the only component of µ responsible for Σ ↔ Σ transitions, has (+) symmetry. Therefore, for a (+) ↔ (−) transition, the overall symmetry of the transition dipole moment is (+) × (+) × (−) = (−), so it must be zero. Therefore, for Σ terms, Σ+ ↔ Σ− transitions are not allowed. A forbidden g → g transition can become allowed if the centre of symmetry is eliminated by an asymmetrical vibration, such as the one shown in Fig. 14.5. When the centre of symmetry is lost, g → g and u → u transitions are no longer parity-forbidden and become weakly allowed. A transition that derives its intensity from an asymmetrical vibration of a molecule is called a vibronic transition. Self-test 14.1 Which of the following electronic transitions are allowed in O2: 3 Σg − ↔ 1 ∆g , 3 Σg − ↔ 1 Σg + , 3 Σg − ↔ 3 ∆u, 3 Σg − ↔3 Σu + , 3 Σg − ↔3 Σu − ? [3 Σg − ↔3 Σu − ] (c) Vibrational structure To account for the vibrational structure in electronic spectra of molecules (Fig. 14.6), we apply the Franck–Condon principle: Because the nuclei are so much more massive than the electrons, an electronic transition takes place very much faster than the nuclei can respond. As a result of the transition, electron density is rapidly built up in new regions of the molecule and removed from others. The initially stationary nuclei suddenly experience a new force field, to which they respond by beginning to vibrate and (in classical terms) swing backwards and forwards from their original separation (which was maintained during the rapid electronic excitation). The stationary equilibrium separation of the nuclei in the initial electronic state therefore becomes a stationary turning point in the final electronic state (Fig. 14.7). The quantum mechanical version of the Franck–Condon principle refines this picture. Before the absorption, the molecule is in the lowest vibrational state of its lowest electronic state (Fig. 14.8); the most probable location of the nuclei is at their equilibrium separation, Re. The electronic transition is most likely to take place when the nuclei have this separation. When the transition occurs, the molecule is excited to the state represented by the upper curve. According to the Franck–Condon principle, the nuclear framework remains constant during this excitation, so we may imagine the transition as being up the vertical line in Fig. 14.7. The vertical line is the origin of the expression vertical transition, which is used to denote an electronic transition that occurs without change of nuclear geometry. The vertical transition cuts through several vibrational levels of the upper electronic state. The level marked * is the one in which the nuclei are most probably at Fig. 14.5 A d–d transition is parityforbidden because it corresponds to a g–g transition. However, a vibration of the molecule can destroy the inversion symmetry of the molecule and the g,u classification no longer applies. The removal of the centre of symmetry gives rise to a vibronically allowed transition. 400 300 200 100 0 200 240 280 320 /(dmmolcm) 311 /nml e–– Fig. 14.6 The electronic spectra of some molecules show significant vibrational structure. Shown here is the ultraviolet spectrum of gaseous SO2 at 298 K. As explained in the text, the sharp lines in this spectrum are due to transitions from a lower electronic state to different vibrational levels of a higher electronic state. 14.1 THE ELECTRONIC SPECTRA OF DIATOMIC MOLECULES 485 the same initial separation Re (because the vibrational wavefunction has maximum amplitude there), so this vibrational state is the most probable state for the termination of the transition. However, it is not the only accessible vibrational state because several nearby states have an appreciable probability of the nuclei being at the separation Re. Therefore, transitions occur to all the vibrational states in this region, but most intensely to the state with a vibrational wavefunction that peaks most strongly near Re. The vibrational structure of the spectrum depends on the relative horizontal position of the two potential energy curves, and a long vibrational progression, a lot of vibrational structure, is stimulated if the upper potential energy curve is appreciably displaced horizontally from the lower. The upper curve is usually displaced to greater equilibrium bond lengths because electronically excited states usually have more antibonding character than electronic ground states. The separation of the vibrational lines of an electronic absorption spectrum depends on the vibrational energies of the upper electronic state. Hence, electronic absorption spectra may be used to assess the force fields and dissociation energies of electronically excited molecules (for example, by using a Birge–Sponer plot, as in Problem 14.2). (d) Franck–Condon factors The quantitative form of the Franck–Condon principle is derived from the expression for the transition dipole moment, µfi = ͗f|µ|i͘. The dipole moment operator is a sum over all nuclei and electrons in the molecule: ¢ = −e∑ i ri + e∑ I ZIRI (14.2) where the vectors are the distances from the centre of charge of the molecule. The intensityofthetransitionisproportionaltothesquaremodulus,|µfi|2 ,ofthemagnitude of the transition dipole moment (eqn 9.70), and we show in the Justification below that this intensity is proportional to the square modulus of the overlap integral, S(vf,vi), between the vibrational states of the initial and final electronic states. This overlap integral is a measure of the match between the vibrational wavefunctions in the upper and lower electronic states: S = 1 for a perfect match and S = 0 when there is no similarity. Justification 14.2 The Franck–Condon approximation The overall state of the molecule consists of an electronic part, |ε͘, and a vibrational part, |v͘. Therefore, within the Born–Oppenheimer approximation, the transition dipole moment factorizes as follows: µfi = ͗εfvf |{−e∑ i ri + e∑ I ZIRI}|εivi͘ = −e∑ i ͗εf |ri|εi͗͘vf |vi͘ + e∑ i Zi͗εf |εi͗͘vf |RI|vi͘ The second term on the right of the second row is zero, because ͗εf |εi͘ = 0 for two different electronic states (they are orthogonal). Therefore, µfi = −e∑ i ͗εf |ri |εi͗͘vf |vi͘ = µεf,εi S(vf,vi) (14.3) where µεf,εi = −e∑ i ͗εf |ri|εi͘ S(vf,vi) = ͗vf |vi͘ (14.4) The matrix element µεf,εi is the electric-dipole transition moment arising from the redistribution of electrons (and a measure of the ‘kick’ this redistribution gives to the electromagnetic field, and vice versa for absorption). The factor S(vf,vi), is the overlap integral between the vibrational state |vi͘ in the initial electronic state of the molecule, and the vibrational state |vf͘ in the final electronic state of the molecule. Turning point (stationary nuclei) Electronic excited state Electronic ground state Nuclei stationary Molecularpotentialenergy Internuclear separation Electronic excited state Electronic ground state Molecularpotentialenergy Internuclear separation * Fig. 14.7 According to the Franck–Condon principle, the most intense vibronic transition is from the ground vibrational state to the vibrational state lying vertically above it. Transitions to other vibrational levels also occur, but with lower intensity. Fig. 14.8 In the quantum mechanical version of the Franck–Condon principle, the molecule undergoes a transition to the upper vibrational state that most closely resembles the vibrational wavefunction of the vibrational ground state of the lower electronic state. The two wavefunctions shown here have the greatest overlap integral of all the vibrational states of the upper electronic state and hence are most closely similar. 486 14 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 2: ELECTRONIC TRANSITIONS 0.5 1 0 0 2 4 S(0,0)2 ( – )/2R Re e¢ 1/2 a Fig. 14.9 The Franck–Condon factor for the arrangement discussed in Example 14.1. Fig. 14.10 The model wavefunctions used in Self-test 14.2. Because the transition intensity is proportional to the square of the magnitude of thetransitiondipolemoment,theintensityofanabsorptionisproportionalto|S(vf,vi)|2 , which is known as the Franck–Condon factor for the transition. It follows that, the greater the overlap of the vibrational state wavefunction in the upper electronic state with the vibrational wavefunction in the lower electronic state, the greater the absorption intensity of that particular simultaneous electronic and vibrational transition. This conclusion is the basis of the illustration in Fig. 14.8, where we see that the vibrational wavefunction of the ground state has the greatest overlap with the vibrational states that have peaks at similar bond lengths in the upper electronic state. Example 14.1 Calculating a Franck–Condon factor Consider the transition from one electronic state to another, their bond lengths being Re and Re′ and their force constants equal. Calculate the Franck–Condon factor for the 0–0 transition and show that the transition is most intense when the bond lengths are equal. Method We need to calculate S(0,0), the overlap integral of the two ground-state vibrationalwavefunctions,andthentakeitssquare.Thedifferencebetweenharmonic and anharmonic vibrational wavefunctions is negligible for v = 0, so harmonic oscillator wavefunctions can be used (Table 9.1). Answer We use the (real) wavefunctions ψ0 = 1/2 e−x2 /2α2 ψ ′0 = 1/2 e−x′2 /2α2 where x = R − Re and x′ = R − R′e, with α = ($2 /mk)1/4 (Section 9.5a). The overlap integral is S(0,0) = ͗0|0͘ = Ύ ∞ −∞ ψ′0ψ0dR = Ύ ∞ −∞ e−(x2 +x′2 )/2α2 dx We now write αz = R − 1 –2(Re + R′e), and manipulate this expression into S(0,0) = e−(Re−R′e)2 /4α2 Ύ ∞ −∞ e−z2 dz The value of the integral is π1/2 . Therefore, the overlap integral is S(0,0) = e−(Re−R′e)2 /4α2 and the Franck–Condon factor is S(0,0)2 = e−(Re−R′e)2 /2α2 This factor is equal to 1 when R′e = Re and decreases as the equilibrium bond lengths diverge from each other (Fig. 14.9). For Br2, Re = 228 pm and there is an upper state with R′e = 266 pm. Taking the vibrational wavenumber as 250 cm−1 gives S(0,0)2 = 5.1 × 10−10 , so the intensity of the 0–0 transition is only 5.1 × 10−10 what it would have been if the potential curves had been directly above each other. Self-test 14.2 Suppose the vibrational wavefunctions can be approximated by rectangular functions of width W and W′, centred on the equilibrium bond lengths (Fig. 14.10). Find the corresponding Franck–Condon factors when the centres are coincident and W′ < W. [S2 = W′/W] 1 π1/2 1 απ1/2 D F 1 απ1/2 A C D F 1 απ1/2 A C 14.2 THE ELECTRONIC SPECTRA OF POLYATOMIC MOLECULES 487 (e) Rotational structure Just as in vibrational spectroscopy, where a vibrational transition is accompanied by rotational excitation, so rotational transitions accompany the excitation of the vibrational excitation that accompanies electronic excitation. We therefore see P, Q, and R branches for each vibrational transition, and the electronic transition has a very rich structure. However, the principal difference is that electronic excitation can result in much larger changes in bond length than vibrational excitation causes alone, and the rotational branches have a more complex structure than in vibration–rotation spectra. We suppose that the rotational constants of the electronic ground and excited states are B and B′, respectively. The rotational energy levels of the initial and final states are E(J) = hcBJ(J + 1) E(J′) = hcB′J′(J′ + 1) and the rotational transitions occur at the following positions relative to the vibrational transition of wavenumber # that they accompany: P branch (∆J = −1): #P(J) = # − (B′ + B)J + (B′ − B)J2 (14.5a) Q branch (∆J = 0): #Q(J) = # + (B′ − B)J(J + 1) (14.5b) R branch (∆J = +1): #R(J) = # + (B′ + B)(J + 1) + (B′ − B)(J + 1)2 (14.5c) (These are the analogues of eqn 13.63.) First, suppose that the bond length in the electronically excited state is greater than that in the ground state; then B′ < B and B′ − B is negative. In this case the lines of the R branch converge with increasing J and when J is such that |B′ − B|(J + 1) > B′ + B the lines start to appear at successively decreasing wavenumbers. That is, the R branch has a band head (Fig. 14.11a). When the bond is shorter in the excited state than in the ground state, B′ > B and B′ − B is positive. In this case, the lines of the P branch begin to converge and go through a head when J is such that (B′ − B)J > B′ + B (Fig. 14.11b). 14.2 The electronic spectra of polyatomic molecules The absorption of a photon can often be traced to the excitation of specific types of electrons or to electrons that belong to a small group of atoms in a polyatomic molecule. For example, when a carbonyl group (> C=O) is present, an absorption at about 290 nm is normally observed, although its precise location depends on the nature of the rest of the molecule. Groups with characteristic optical absorptions are called chromophores (from the Greek for ‘colour bringer’), and their presence often accounts for the colours of substances (Table 14.3). (a) d–d transitions In a free atom, all five d orbitals of a given shell are degenerate. In a d-metal complex, where the immediate environment of the atom is no longer spherical, the d orbitals P R P R (a) B' B< (b) B' B> Fig. 14.11 When the rotational constants of a diatomic molecule differ significantly in the initial and final states of an electronic transition, the P and R branches show a head. (a) The formation of a head in the R branch when B′ < B; (b) the formation of a head in the P branch when B′ > B. Comment 14.2 The web site for this text contains links to databases of electronic spectra. Synoptic table 14.3* Absorption characteristics ofsome groups and molecules Group #/cm−1 λmax/nm ε/(dm3 mol−1 cm−1 ) C=C (π* ← π) 61 000 163 5 000 57 300 174 15 500 C=O (π* ← n) 35 000–37 000 270–290 10–20 H2O (π* ← n) 60 000 167 7 000 * More values are given in the Data section. 488 14 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 2: ELECTRONIC TRANSITIONS are not all degenerate, and electrons can absorb energy by making transitions between them. We show in the following Justification that in an octahedral complex, such as [Ti(OH2)6]3+ (1), the five d orbitals of the central atom are split into two sets (2), a triply degenerate set labelled t2g and a doubly degenerate set labelled eg. The three t2g orbitals lie below the two eg orbitals; the difference in energy is denoted ∆O and called the ligand-field splitting parameter (the O denoting octahedral symmetry). Justification 14.3 The splitting of d-orbitals in an octahedral d-metal complex In an octahedral d-metal complex, six identical ions or molecules, the ligands, are at the vertices of a regular octahedron, with the metal ion at its centre. The ligands can be regarded as point negative charges that are repelled by the d-electrons of the central ion. Figure 14.12 shows the consequence of this arrangement: the five d-orbitals fall into two groups, with dx2 −y2 and dz2 pointing directly towards the ligand positions, and dxy, dyz, and dzx pointing between them. An electron occupying an orbital of the former group has a less favourable potential energy than when it occupies any of the three orbitals of the other group, and so the d-orbitals split into the two sets shown in (2) with an energy difference ∆O: a triply degenerate set comprising the dxy, dyz, and dzx orbitals and labelled t2g, and a doubly degenerate set comprising the dx2 −y2 and dz2 orbitals and labelled eg. The d-orbitals also divide into two sets in a tetrahedral complex, but in this case the e orbitals lie below the t2 orbitals and their separation is written ∆T. Neither ∆O nor ∆T is large, so transitions between the two sets of orbitals typically occur in the visible region of the spectrum. The transitions are responsible for many of the colours that aresocharacteristicof d-metalcomplexes.Asanexample,thespectrumof[Ti(OH2)6]3+ near 20 000 cm−1 (500 nm) is shown in Fig. 14.13, and can be ascribed to the promotion of its single d electron from a t2g orbital to an eg orbital. The wavenumber of the absorption maximum suggests that ∆O ≈ 20 000 cm−1 for this complex, which corresponds to about 2.5 eV. Ti H O2 3+ 1 [Ti(OH ) ]2 6 3+ d eg t2g DO DO DO -5 3 -5 2 2 dz 2 dx y2 2 dzx dyz dxy x y z eg t2g Fig. 14.12 The classification of d-orbitals in an octahedral environment. Fig. 14.13 The electronic absorption spectrum of [Ti(OH2)6]3+ in aqueous solution. 14.2 THE ELECTRONIC SPECTRA OF POLYATOMIC MOLECULES 489 According to the Laporte rule (Section 14.1b), d–d transitions are parity-forbidden in octahedral complexes because they are g → g transitions (more specifically eg ← t2g transitions). However, d–d transitions become weakly allowed as vibronic transitions as a result of coupling to asymmetrical vibrations such as that shown in Fig. 14.5. (b) Charge-transfer transitions A complex may absorb radiation as a result of the transfer of an electron from the ligands into the d-orbitals of the central atom, or vice versa. In such charge-transfer transitions the electron moves through a considerable distance, which means that the transition dipole moment may be large and the absorption is correspondingly intense. This mode of chromophore activity is shown by the permanganate ion, MnO4 − , and accounts for its intense violet colour (which arises from strong absorption within the range 420–700 nm). In this oxoanion, the electron migrates from an orbital that is largely confined to the O atom ligands to an orbital that is largely confined to the Mn atom. It is therefore an example of a ligand-to-metal charge-transfer transition (LMCT). The reverse migration, a metal-to-ligand charge-transfer transition (MLCT), can also occur. An example is the transfer of a d electron into the antibonding π orbitals of an aromatic ligand. The resulting excited state may have a very long lifetime if the electron is extensively delocalized over several aromatic rings, and such species can participate in photochemically induced redox reactions (see Section 23.7). The intensities of charge-transfer transitions are proportional to the square of the transition dipole moment, in the usual way. We can think of the transition moment as a measure of the distance moved by the electron as it migrates from metal to ligand or vice versa, with a large distance of migration corresponding to a large transition dipole moment and therefore a high intensity of absorption. However, because the integrand in the transition dipole is proportional to the product of the initial and final wavefunctions, it is zero unless the two wavefunctions have nonzero values in the same region of space. Therefore, although large distances of migration favour high intensities, the diminished overlap of the initial and final wavefunctions for large separations of metal and ligands favours low intensities (see Problem 14.17). We encounter similar considerations when we examine electron transfer reactions (Chapter 24), which can be regarded as a special type of charge-transfer transition. (c) π* ← π and π* ← n transitions Absorption by a C=C double bond results in the excitation of a π electron into an antibonding π* orbital (Fig. 14.14). The chromophore activity is therefore due to a π* ← π transition (which is normally read ‘π to π-star transition’). Its energy is about 7 eV for an unconjugated double bond, which corresponds to an absorption at 180 nm (in the ultraviolet). When the double bond is part of a conjugated chain, the energies of the molecular orbitals lie closer together and the π* ← π transition moves to longer wavelength; it may even lie in the visible region if the conjugated system is long enough. An important example of an π* ← π transition is provided by the photochemical mechanism of vision (Impact I14.1). The transition responsible for absorption in carbonyl compounds can be traced to the lone pairs of electrons on the O atom. The Lewis concept of a ‘lone pair’ of electrons is represented in molecular orbital theory by a pair of electrons in an orbital confined largely to one atom and not appreciably involved in bond formation. One of these electrons may be excited into an empty π* orbital of the carbonyl group (Fig. 14.15), which gives rise to a π* ← n transition (an ‘n to π-star transition’). Typical absorption energies are about 4 eV (290 nm). Because π* ← n transitions in carbonyls are symmetry forbidden, the absorptions are weak. p *p Fig. 14.14 A C=C double bond acts as a chromophore. One of its important transitions is the π* ← π transition illustrated here, in which an electron is promoted from a π orbital to the corresponding antibonding orbital. * n p Fig. 14.15 A carbonyl group (C=O) acts as a chromophore primarily on account of the excitation of a nonbonding O lone-pair electron to an antibonding CO π orbital. 490 14 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 2: ELECTRONIC TRANSITIONS (d) Circular dichroism spectroscopy Electronic spectra can reveal additional details of molecular structure when experiments are conducted with polarizedlight, electromagnetic radiation with electric and magnetic fields that oscillate only in certain directions. Light is plane polarized when the electric and magnetic fields each oscillate in a single plane (Fig. 14.16). The plane of polarization may be oriented in any direction around the direction of propagation (the x-direction in Fig. 14.16), with the electric and magnetic fields perpendicular to that direction (and perpendicular to each other). An alternative mode of polarization is circular polarization, in which the electric and magnetic fields rotate around the direction of propagation in either a clockwise or a counter-clockwise sense but remain perpendicular to it and each other. When plane-polarized radiation passes through samples of certain kinds of matter, the plane of polarization is rotated around the direction of propagation. This rotation is the familiar phenomenon of optical activity, observed when the molecules in the sample are chiral (Section 12.3b). Chiral molecules have a second characteristic: they absorb left and right circularly polarized light to different extents. In a circularly polarized ray of light, the electric field describes a helical path as the wave travels through space (Fig. 14.17), and the rotation may be either clockwise or counterclockwise. The differential absorption of left- and right-circularly polarized light is called circular dichroism. In terms of the absorbances for the two components, AL and AR, the circular dichroism of a sample of molar concentration [J] is reported as ∆ε = εL − εR = (14.6) where l is the path length of the sample. Circular dichroism is a useful adjunct to visible and UV spectroscopy. For example, the CD spectra of the enantiomeric pairs of chiral d-metal complexes are distinctly different, whereas there is little difference between their absorption spectra (Fig. 14.18). Moreover, CD spectra can be used to assign the absolute configuration of complexes by comparing the observed spectrum with the CD spectrum of a similar complex of known handedness. We shall see in Chapter 19 that the CD spectra of biological polymers, such as proteins and nucleic acids, give similar structural information. In these cases the spectrum of the polymer chain arises from the chirality of individual monomer units and, in addition, a contribution from the three-dimensional structure of the polymer itself. IMPACT ON BIOCHEMISTRY I14.1 Vision The eye is an exquisite photochemical organ that acts as a transducer, converting radiant energy into electrical signals that travel along neurons. Here we concentrate on the events taking place in the human eye, but similar processes occur in all animals. Indeed, a single type of protein, rhodopsin, is the primary receptor for light throughout the animal kingdom, which indicates that vision emerged very early in evolutionary history, no doubt because of its enormous value for survival. Photons enter the eye through the cornea, pass through the ocular fluid that fills the eye, and fall on the retina. The ocular fluid is principally water, and passage of light through this medium is largely responsible for the chromatic aberration of the eye, the blurring of the image as a result of different frequencies being brought to slightly different focuses. The chromatic aberration is reduced to some extent by the tinted region called the macular pigment that covers part of the retina. The pigments in this region are the carotene-like xanthophylls (3), which absorb some of the blue light and AL − AR [J]l x y Magnetic field Electric field z Propagation Fig. 14.16 Electromagnetic radiation consists of a wave of electric and magnetic fields perpendicular to the direction of propagation (in this case the x-direction), and mutually perpendicular to each other. This illustration shows a plane-polarized wave, with the electric and magnetic fields oscillating in the xy and xz planes, respectively. R L (a) (b) Fig. 14.17 In circularly polarized light, the electric field at different points along the direction of propagation rotates. The arrays of arrows in these illustrations show the view of the electric field when looking toward the oncoming ray: (a) rightcircularly polarized, (b) left-circularly polarized light. I14.1 IMPACT ON BIOCHEMISTRY: VISION 491 hence help to sharpen the image. They also protect the photoreceptor molecules from too great a flux of potentially dangerous high energy photons. The xanthophylls have delocalized electrons that spread along the chain of conjugated double bonds, and the π* ← π transition lies in the visible. About 57 per cent of the photons that enter the eye reach the retina; the rest are scattered or absorbed by the ocular fluid. Here the primary act of vision takes place, in which the chromophore of a rhodopsin molecule absorbs a photon in another π* ← π transition. A rhodopsin molecule consists of an opsin protein molecule to which is attached a 11-cis-retinal molecule (4). The latter resembles half a carotene molecule, showing Nature’s economy in its use of available materials. The attachment is by the formation of a protonated Schiff’s base, utilizing the -CHO group of the chromophore and the terminal NH2 group of the sidechain, a lysine residue from opsin. The free 11-cis-retinal molecule absorbs in the ultraviolet, but attachment to the opsin protein molecule shifts the absorption into the visible region. The rhodopsin molecules are situated in the membranes of special cells (the ‘rods’ and the ‘cones’) that cover the retina. The opsin molecule is anchored into the cell membrane by two hydrophobic groups and largely surrounds the chromophore (Fig. 14.19). Immediately after the absorption of a photon, the 11-cis-retinal molecule undergoes photoisomerization into all-trans-retinal (5). Photoisomerization takes about Fig. 14.18 (a) The absorption spectra of two isomers, denoted mer and fac, of [Co(ala)3], where ala is the conjugate base of alanine, and (b) the corresponding CD spectra. The left- and right-handed forms of these isomers give identical absorption spectra. However, the CD spectra are distinctly different, and the absolute configurations (denoted Λ and ∆) have been assigned by comparison with the CD spectra of a complex of known absolute configuration. e 20 25 30 /(10 cm )3 1-~ 20 25 30 /(10 cm )3 1-~ D 20 25 30 /(10 cm )3 1-~ 20 25 30 /(10 cm )3 1-~ L D L D N N N O OO N N N O OO (a) (b) n n n n e 492 14 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 2: ELECTRONIC TRANSITIONS 200 fs and about 67 pigment molecules isomerize for every 100 photons that are absorbed. The process occurs because the π* ← π excitation of an electron loosens one of the π-bonds (the one indicated by the arrow in 5), its torsional rigidity is lost, and one part of the molecule swings round into its new position. At that point, the molecule returns to its ground state, but is now trapped in its new conformation. The straightened tail of all-trans-retinal results in the molecule taking up more space than 11-cis-retinal did, so the molecule presses against the coils of the opsin molecule that surrounds it. In about 0.25–0.50 ms from the initial absorption event, the rhodopsin molecule is activated both by the isomerization of retinal and deprotonation of its Schiff’s base tether to opsin, forming an intermediate known as metarhodopsin II. In a sequence of biochemical events known as the biochemical cascade, metarhodopsin II activates the protein transducin, which in turn activates a phosphodiesterase enzyme that hydrolyses cyclic guanine monophosphate (cGMP) to GMP. The reduction in the concentration of cGMP causes ion channels, proteins that mediate the movement of ions across biological membranes, to close and the result is a sizable change in the transmembrane potential (see Impact I7.2 for a discussion of transmembrane potentials). The pulse of electric potential travels through the optical nerve and into the optical cortex, where it is interpreted as a signal and incorporated into the web of events we call ‘vision’. The resting state of the rhodopsin molecule is restored by a series of nonradiative chemical events powered by ATP. The process involves the escape of all-trans-retinal as all-trans-retinol (in which -CHO has been reduced to -CH2OH) from the opsin molecule by a process catalysed by the enzyme rhodopsin kinase and the attachment of another protein molecule, arrestin. The free all-trans-retinol molecule now undergoes enzyme-catalysed isomerization into 11-cis-retinol followed by dehydrogenation to form 11-cis-retinal, which is then delivered back into an opsin molecule. At this point, the cycle of excitation, photoisomerization, and regeneration is ready to begin again. The fates of electronically excited states A radiative decay process is a process in which a molecule discards its excitation energy as a photon. A more common fate is nonradiative decay, in which the excess energy is transferred into the vibration, rotation, and translation of the surrounding molecules. This thermal degradation converts the excitation energy completely into thermal motion of the environment (that is, to ‘heat’). An excited molecule may also take part in a chemical reaction, as we discuss in Chapter 23. 14.3 Fluorescence and phosphorescence In fluorescence, spontaneous emission of radiation occurs within a few nanoseconds after the exciting radiation is extinguished (Fig. 14.20). In phosphorescence, the spontaneous emission may persist for long periods (even hours, but characteristically seconds or fractions of seconds). The difference suggests that fluorescence is a fast conversion of absorbed radiation into re-emitted energy, and that phosphorescence involves the storage of energy in a reservoir from which it slowly leaks. (a) Fluorescence Figure 14.21 shows the sequence of steps involved in fluorescence. The initial absorption takes the molecule to an excited electronic state, and if the absorption spectrum were monitored it would look like the one shown in Fig. 14.22a. The excited molecule Time Emissionintensity Fluorescence Phosphorescence Illuminationon Fig. 14.20 The empirical (observationbased) distinction between fluorescence and phosphorescence is that the former is extinguished very quickly after the exciting source is removed, whereas the latter continues with relatively slowly diminishing intensity. Fig. 14.19 The structure of the rhodopsin molecule, consisting of an opsin protein to which is attached an 11-cis-retinal molecule embedded in the space surrounded by the helical regions. 14.3 FLUORESCENCE AND PHOSPHORESCENCE 493 is subjected to collisions with the surrounding molecules, and as it gives up energy nonradiatively it steps down the ladder of vibrational levels to the lowest vibrational level of the electronically excited molecular state. The surrounding molecules, however, might now be unable to accept the larger energy difference needed to lower the molecule to the ground electronic state. It might therefore survive long enough to undergo spontaneous emission, and emit the remaining excess energy as radiation. The downward electronic transition is vertical (in accord with the Franck–Condon principle) and the fluorescence spectrum has a vibrational structure characteristic of the lower electronic state (Fig. 14.22b). Provided they can be seen, the 0–0 absorption and fluorescence transitions can be expected to be coincident. The absorption spectrum arises from 1–0, 2–0, . . . transitions that occur at progressively higher wavenumber and with intensities governed by the Franck–Condon principle. The fluorescence spectrum arises from 0–0, 0–1, . . . downward transitions that hence occur with decreasing wavenumbers. The 0–0 absorption and fluorescence peaks are not always exactly coincident, however, because the solvent may interact differently with the solute in the ground and excited states (for instance, the hydrogen bonding pattern might differ). Because the solvent molecules do not have time to rearrange during the transition, the absorption occurs in an environment characteristic of the solvated ground state; however, the fluorescence occurs in an environment characteristic of the solvated excited state (Fig. 14.23). Fluorescence occurs at lower frequencies (longer wavelengths) than the incident radiation because the emissive transition occurs after some vibrational energy has been discarded into the surroundings. The vivid oranges and greens of fluorescent dyes are an everyday manifestation of this effect: they absorb in the ultraviolet and blue, and fluoresce in the visible. The mechanism also suggests that the intensity of the fluorescence ought to depend on the ability of the solvent molecules to accept the Radiation (fluorescence) Radiationless decay Absorption Molecularpotentialenergy Internuclear separation (a) (b) Absorption Fluorescence Wavelength Characteristic of upper state Characteristic of lower state (0,0) Fig. 14.21 The sequence of steps leading to fluorescence. After the initial absorption, the upper vibrational states undergo radiationless decay by giving up energy to the surroundings. A radiative transition then occurs from the vibrational ground state of the upper electronic state. Fig. 14.22 An absorption spectrum (a) shows a vibrational structure characteristic of the upper state. A fluorescence spectrum (b) shows a structure characteristic of the lower state; it is also displaced to lower frequencies (but the 0–0 transitions are coincident) and resembles a mirror image of the absorption. Absorption Fluorescence Relaxation Relaxation Fig. 14.23 The solvent can shift the fluorescence spectrum relative to the absorption spectrum. On the left we see that the absorption occurs with the solvent (the ellipses) in the arrangement characteristic of the ground electronic state of the molecule (the sphere). However, before fluorescence occurs, the solvent molecules relax into a new arrangement, and that arrangement is preserved during the subsequent radiative transition. 494 14 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 2: ELECTRONIC TRANSITIONS electronicandvibrationalquanta.Itisindeedfoundthatasolventcomposedofmolecules with widely spaced vibrational levels (such as water) can in some cases accept the large quantum of electronic energy and so extinguish, or ‘quench’, the fluorescence. We examine the mechanisms of fluorescence quenching in Chapter 23. (b) Phosphorescence Figure 14.24 shows the sequence of events leading to phosphorescence for a molecule with a singlet ground state. The first steps are the same as in fluorescence, but the presence of a triplet excited state plays a decisive role. The singlet and triplet excited states share a common geometry at the point where their potential energy curves intersect. Hence, if there is a mechanism for unpairing two electron spins (and achieving the conversion of ↑↓ to ↑↑), the molecule may undergo intersystemcrossing, a nonradiative transition between states of different multiplicity, and become a triplet state. We saw in the discussion of atomic spectra (Section 10.9d) that singlet–triplet transitions may occur in the presence of spin–orbit coupling, and the same is true in molecules. We can expect intersystem crossing to be important when a molecule contains a moderately heavy atom (such as S), because then the spin–orbit coupling is large. If an excited molecule crosses into a triplet state, it continues to deposit energy into the surroundings. However, it is now stepping down the triplet’s vibrational ladder, and at the lowest energy level it is trapped because the triplet state is at a lower energy than the corresponding singlet (recall Hund’s rule, Section 13.7). The solvent cannot absorb the final, large quantum of electronic excitation energy, and the molecule can- notradiateitsenergybecausereturntothegroundstateisspin-forbidden(Section14.1). The radiative transition, however, is not totally forbidden because the spin–orbit coupling that was responsible for the intersystem crossing also breaks the selection rule. The molecules are therefore able to emit weakly, and the emission may continue long after the original excited state was formed. The mechanism accounts for the observation that the excitation energy seems to get trapped in a slowly leaking reservoir. It also suggests (as is confirmed experimentally) that phosphorescence should be most intense from solid samples: energy transfer is then less efficient and intersystem crossing has time to occur as the singlet excited state steps slowly past the intersection point. The mechanism also suggests that the phosphorescence efficiency should depend on the presence of a moderately heavy atom (with strong spin–orbit coupling), which is in fact the case. The confirmation of the mechanism is the experimental observation (using the sensitive magnetic resonance techniques described in Chapter 15) that the sample is paramagnetic while the reservoir state, with its unpaired electron spins, is populated. The various types of nonradiative and radiative transitions that can occur in molecules are often represented on a schematic Jablonski diagram of the type shown in Fig. 14.25. IMPACT ON BIOCHEMISTRY I14.2 Fluorescence microscopy Apart from a small number of co-factors, such as the chlorophylls and flavins, the majority of the building blocks of proteins and nucleic acids do not fluoresce strongly. Four notable exceptions are the amino acids tryptophan (λabs ≈ 280 nm and λfluor ≈ 348 nm in water), tyrosine (λabs ≈ 274 nm and λfluor ≈ 303 nm in water), and phenylalanine (λabs ≈ 257 nm and λfluor ≈ 282 nm in water), and the oxidized form of the sequence serine–tyrosine–glycine (6) found in the green fluorescent protein (GFP) of certain jellyfish. The wild type of GFP from Aequora victoria absorbs strongly at 395 nm and emits maximally at 509 nm. Radiation (phosphorescence) Absorption Molecularpotentialenergy Internuclear separation Singlet Intersystem crossing Singlet Triplet 35 30 25 20 15 10 5 0 S0T1 S1 ( , )* 315nm 471nm IC /(10cm) 31~ Phosphorescence Fluorescence ISC ISC ( , )*p p n p p Fig. 14.25 A Jablonski diagram (here, for naphthalene) is a simplified portrayal of the relative positions of the electronic energy levels of a molecule. Vibrational levels of states of a given electronic state lie above each other, but the relative horizontal locations of the columns bear no relation to the nuclear separations in the states. The ground vibrational states of each electronic state are correctly located vertically but the other vibrational states are shown only schematically. (IC: internal conversion; ISC: intersystem crossing.) Fig. 14.24 The sequence of steps leading to phosphorescence. The important step is the intersystem crossing, the switch from a singlet state to a triplet state brought about by spin–orbit coupling. The triplet state acts as a slowly radiating reservoir because the return to the ground state is spin-forbidden. 14.4 DISSOCIATION AND PREDISSOCIATION 495 In fluorescence microscopy, images of biological cells at work are obtained by attaching a large number of fluorescent molecules to proteins, nucleic acids, and membranes and then measuring the distribution of fluorescence intensity within the illuminated area. A common fluorescent label is GFP. With proper filtering to remove light due to Rayleigh scattering of the incident beam, it is possible to collect light from the sample that contains only fluorescence from the label. However, great care is required to eliminate fluorescent impurities from the sample. 14.4 Dissociation and predissociation Another fate for an electronically excited molecule is dissociation, the breaking of bonds (Fig. 14.26). The onset of dissociation can be detected in an absorption spectrum by seeing that the vibrational structure of a band terminates at a certain energy. Absorption occurs in a continuous band above this dissociation limit because the final state is an unquantized translational motion of the fragments. Locating the dissociation limit is a valuable way of determining the bond dissociation energy. In some cases, the vibrational structure disappears but resumes at higher photon energies. This predissociation can be interpreted in terms of the molecular potential energy curves shown in Fig. 14.27. When a molecule is excited to a vibrational level, its electrons may undergo a redistribution that results in it undergoing an internal conversion, a radiationless conversion to another state of the same multiplicity. An internal conversion occurs most readily at the point of intersection of the two molecular potential energy curves, because there the nuclear geometries of the two states are the same. The state into which the molecule converts may be dissociative, so the states near the intersection have a finite lifetime, and hence their energies are imprecisely defined. As a result, the absorption spectrum is blurred in the vicinity of the intersection. When the incoming photon brings enough energy to excite the molecule Dissociation limit Continuum Molecularpotentialenergy Internuclear separation Continuum Dissociation limit Continuum Molecularpotentialenergy Internuclear separation Fig. 14.26 When absorption occurs to unbound states of the upper electronic state, the molecule dissociates and the absorption is a continuum. Below the dissociation limit the electronic spectrum shows a normal vibrational structure. Fig. 14.27 When a dissociative state crosses a bound state, as in the upper part of the illustration, molecules excited to levels near the crossing may dissociate. This process is called predissociation, and is detected in the spectrum as a loss of vibrational structure that resumes at higher frequencies. 496 14 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 2: ELECTRONIC TRANSITIONS to a vibrational level high above the intersection, the internal conversion does not occur (the nuclei are unlikely to have the same geometry). Consequently, the levels resume their well-defined, vibrational character with correspondingly well-defined energies, and the line structure resumes on the high-frequency side of the blurred region. Lasers Lasers have transformed chemistry as much as they have transformed the everyday world. They lie very much on the frontier of physics and chemistry, for their operation depends on details of optics and, in some cases, of solid-state processes. In this section, we discuss the mechanisms of laser action, and then explore their applications in chemistry. In Further information 14.1, we discuss the modes of operation of a number of commonly available laser systems. 14.5 General principles of laser action The word laser is an acronym formed from light amplification by stimulated emission of radiation. In stimulated emission, an excited state is stimulated to emit a photon by radiation of the same frequency; the more photons that are present, the greater the probability of the emission. The essential feature of laser action is positive-feedback: the more photons present of the appropriate frequency, the more photons of that frequency that will be stimulated to form. (a) Population inversion One requirement of laser action is the existence of a metastable excited state, an excited state with a long enough lifetime for it to participate in stimulated emission. Another requirement is the existence of a greater population in the metastable state than in the lower state where the transition terminates, for then there will be a net emission of radiation. Because at thermal equilibrium the opposite is true, it is necessary to achieve a population inversion in which there are more molecules in the upper state than in the lower. One way of achieving population inversion is illustrated in Fig. 14.28. The molecule is excited to an intermediate state I, which then gives up some of its energy nonradiatively and changes into a lower state A; the laser transition is the return of A to the ground state X. Because three energy levels are involved overall, this arrangement leads to a three-level laser. In practice, I consists of many states, all of which can convert to the upper of the two laser states A. The I ← X transition is stimulated with an intense flash of light in the process called pumping. The pumping is often achieved with an electric discharge through xenon or with the light of another laser. The conversion of I to A should be rapid, and the laser transitions from A to X should be relatively slow. The disadvantage of this three-level arrangement is that it is difficult to achieve population inversion, because so many ground-state molecules must be converted to the excited state by the pumping action. The arrangement adopted in a four-level laser simplifies this task by having the laser transition terminate in a state A′ other than the ground state (Fig. 14.29). Because A′ is unpopulated initially, any population in A corresponds to a population inversion, and we can expect laser action if A is sufficiently metastable. Moreover, this population inversion can be maintained if the A′ ← X transitions are rapid, for these transitions will deplete any population in A′ that stems from the laser transition, and keep the state A′ relatively empty. I A X Pump Laseraction I A A¢ X Pump Laser action Fig. 14.28 The transitions involved in one kind of three-level laser. The pumping pulse populates the intermediate state I, which in turn populates the laser state A. The laser transition is the stimulated emission A → X. Fig. 14.29 The transitions involved in a fourlevel laser. Because the laser transition terminates in an excited state (A′), the population inversion between A and A′ is much easier to achieve. 14.5 GENERAL PRINCIPLES OF LASER ACTION 497 (b) Cavity and mode characteristics The laser medium is confined to a cavity that ensures that only certain photons of a particular frequency, direction of travel, and state of polarization are generated abundantly. The cavity is essentially a region between two mirrors, which reflect the light back and forth. This arrangement can be regarded as a version of the particle in a box, with the particle now being a photon. As in the treatment of a particle in a box (Section 9.1), the only wavelengths that can be sustained satisfy n × 1 –2λ = L (14.7) where n is an integer and L is the length of the cavity. That is, only an integral number of half-wavelengths fit into the cavity; all other waves undergo destructive interference with themselves. In addition, not all wavelengths that can be sustained by the cavity are amplified by the laser medium (many fall outside the range of frequencies of the laser transitions), so only a few contribute to the laser radiation. These wavelengths are the resonant modes of the laser. Photons with the correct wavelength for the resonant modes of the cavity and the correct frequency to stimulate the laser transition are highly amplified. One photon might be generated spontaneously, and travel through the medium. It stimulates the emission of another photon, which in turn stimulates more (Fig. 14.30). The cascade of energy builds up rapidly, and soon the cavity is an intense reservoir of radiation at all the resonant modes it can sustain. Some of this radiation can be withdrawn if one of the mirrors is partially transmitting. The resonant modes of the cavity have various natural characteristics, and to some extent may be selected. Only photons that are travelling strictly parallel to the axis of the cavity undergo more than a couple of reflections, so only they are amplified, all others simply vanishing into the surroundings. Hence, laser light generally forms a beam with very low divergence. It may also be polarized, with its electric vector in a particular plane (or in some other state of polarization), by including a polarizing filter into the cavity or by making use of polarized transitions in a solid medium. Laser radiation is coherent in the sense that the electromagnetic waves are all in step. In spatial coherence the waves are in step across the cross-section of the beam emerging from the cavity. In temporal coherence the waves remain in step along the beam. The latter is normally expressed in terms of a coherence length, lC, the distance over which the waves remain coherent, and is related to the range of wavelengths, ∆λ present in the beam: lC = (14.8) If the beam were perfectly monochromatic, with strictly one wavelength present, ∆λ would be zero and the waves would remain in step for an infinite distance. When many wavelengths are present, the waves get out of step in a short distance and the coherence length is small. A typical light bulb gives out light with a coherence length of only about 400 nm; a He–Ne laser with ∆λ ≈ 2 pm has a coherence length of about 10 cm. (c) Q-switching A laser can generate radiation for as long as the population inversion is maintained. A laser can operate continuously when heat is easily dissipated, for then the population of the upper level can be replenished by pumping. When overheating is a problem, the laser can be operated only in pulses, perhaps of microsecond or millisecond duration, so that the medium has a chance to cool or the lower state discard its population. λ2 2∆λ Pump (a)Thermal equilibrium (b) Population inversion (c) Laser action Fig. 14.30 A schematic illustration of the steps leading to laser action. (a) The Boltzmann population of states (see Molecular interpretation 3.1), with more atoms in the ground state. (b) When the initial state absorbs, the populations are inverted (the atoms are pumped to the excited state). (c) A cascade of radiation then occurs, as one emitted photon stimulates another atom to emit, and so on. The radiation is coherent (phases in step). 498 14 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 2: ELECTRONIC TRANSITIONS Pump Switch Pulse Cavity resonant Cavity nonresonant (a) (b) - + - + - + Laser mediumCircularly polarized radiation Plane polarized radiationPockels cell(a) (b) (c) Fig. 14.31 The principle of Q-switching. The excited state is populated while the cavity is nonresonant. Then the resonance characteristics are suddenly restored, and the stimulated emission emerges in a giant pulse. Fig. 14.32 The principle of a Pockels cell. When light passes through a cell that is ‘on’, its plane of polarization is rotated and so the laser cavity is non-resonant (its Qfactor is reduced). In this sequence, (a) the plane polarized ray becomes circularly polarized, (b) is reflected, and (c) emerges from the Pockels cell with perpendicular plane polarization. When the cell is turned off, no change of polarization occurs, and the cavity becomes resonant. However, it is sometimes desirable to have pulses of radiation rather than a continuous output, with a lot of power concentrated into a brief pulse. One way of achieving pulses is by Q-switching, the modification of the resonance characteristics of the laser cavity. The name comes from the ‘Q-factor’ used as a measure of the quality of a resonance cavity in microwave engineering. Example 14.2 Relating the power and energy of a laser A laser rated at 0.10 J can generate radiation in 3.0 ns pulses at a pulse repetition rate of 10 Hz. Assuming that the pulses are rectangular, calculate the peak power output and the average power output of this laser. Method The power output is the energy released in an interval divided by the duration of the interval, and is expressed in watts (1 W = 1 J s−1 ). To calculate the peak power output, Ppeak, we divide the energy released during the pulse divided by the duration of the pulse. The average power output, Paverage, is the total energy released by a large number of pulses divided by the duration of the time interval over which the total energy was measured. So, the average power is simply the energy released by one pulse multiplied by the pulse repetition rate. Answer From the data, Ppeak = = 3.3 × 107 J s−1 That is, the peak power output is 33 MW. The pulse repetition rate is 10 Hz, so ten pulses are emitted by the laser for every second of operation. It follows that the average power output is Paverage = 0.10 J × 10 s−1 = 1.0 J s−1 = 1.0 W The peak power is much higher than the average power because this laser emits light for only 30 ns during each second of operation. Self-test 14.3 Calculate the peak power and average power output of a laser with a pulse energy of 2.0 mJ, a pulse duration of 30 ps, and a pulse repetition rate of 38 MHz. [Ppeak = 67 MW, Paverage = 76 kW] The aim of Q-switching is to achieve a healthy population inversion in the absence of the resonant cavity, then to plunge the population-inverted medium into a cavity, and hence to obtain a sudden pulse of radiation. The switching may be achieved by impairing the resonance characteristics of the cavity in some way while the pumping pulse is active, and then suddenly to improve them (Fig. 14.31). One technique is to use a Pockels cell, which is an electro-optical device based on the ability of some crystals, such as those of potassium dihydrogenphosphate (KH2PO4), to convert plane-polarized light to circularly polarized light when an electrical potential difference is applied. If a Pockels cell is made part of a laser cavity, then its action and the change in polarization that occurs when light is reflected from a mirror convert light polarized in one plane into reflected light polarized in the perpendicular plane (Fig. 14.32). As a result, the reflected light does not stimulate more emission. However, if the cell is suddenly turned off, the polarization effect is extinguished and all the energy stored in the cavity can emerge as an intense pulse of stimulated emission. An alternative technique is to use a saturable absorber, typically a solution of a dye that loses its ability 0.10 J 3.0 × 10−9 s 14.5 GENERAL PRINCIPLES OF LASER ACTION 499 to absorb when many of its molecules have been excited by intense radiation. The dye then suddenly becomes transparent and the cavity becomes resonant. In practice, Q-switching can give pulses of about 5 ns duration. (d) Mode locking The technique of mode locking can produce pulses of picosecond duration and less. A laser radiates at a number of different frequencies, depending on the precise details of the resonance characteristics of the cavity and in particular on the number of halfwavelengths of radiation that can be trapped between the mirrors (the cavity modes). The resonant modes differ in frequency by multiples of c/2L (as can be inferred from eqn 14.8 with ν = c/λ). Normally, these modes have random phases relative to each other. However, it is possible to lock their phases together. Then interference occurs to give a series of sharp peaks, and the energy of the laser is obtained in short bursts (Fig. 14.33). The sharpness of the peaks depends on the range of modes superimposed, and the wider the range, the narrower the pulses. In a laser with a cavity of length 30 cm, the peaks are separated by 2 ns. If 1000 modes contribute, the width of the pulses is 4 ps. Justification 14.4 The origin of mode locking The general expression for a (complex) wave of amplitude E0 and frequency ω is E0eiωt . Therefore, each wave that can be supported by a cavity of length L has the form En(t) = E0e2π(ν+nc/2L)t where ν is the lowest frequency. A wave formed by superimposing N modes with n = 0, 1, . . . , N − 1 has the form E(t) = N−1 ∑ n=0 En(t) = E0e2πiνt N−1 ∑ n=0 eiπnct/L The sum is a geometrical progression: N−1 ∑ n=0 eiπnct/L = 1 + eiπct/L + e2iπct/L + · · · = × e(N−1)iπct/2L The intensity, I, of the radiation is proportional to the square modulus of the total amplitude, so I ∝ E*E = E0 2 This function is shown in Fig. 14.34. We see that it is a series of peaks with maxima separated by t = 2L/c, the round-trip transit time of the light in the cavity, and that the peaks become sharper as N is increased. Mode locking is achieved by varying the Q-factor of the cavity periodically at the frequency c/2L. The modulation can be pictured as the opening of a shutter in synchrony with the round-trip travel time of the photons in the cavity, so only photons making the journey in that time are amplified. The modulation can be achieved by linking a prism in the cavity to a transducer driven by a radiofrequency source at a frequency c/2L. The transducer sets up standing-wave vibrations in the prism and modulates the sin2 (Nπct/2L) sin2 (πct/2L) sin(Nπct/2L) sin(πct/2L) 1ps1ns Time Fig. 14.33 The output of a mode-locked laser consists of a stream of very narrow pulses separated by an interval equal to the time it takes for light to make a round trip inside the cavity. 0 1 2 3 4 5 ct L/2 Intensity,I Fig. 14.34 The function derived in Justification 14.4 showing in more detail the structure of the pulses generated by a mode-locked laser. 500 14 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 2: ELECTRONIC TRANSITIONS loss it introduces into the cavity. We also see in Section 20.10c that the unique optical properties of some materials can be exploited to bring about mode-locking. 14.6 Applications of lasers in chemistry Laser radiation has five striking characteristics (Table 14.4). Each of them (sometimes in combination with the others) opens up interesting opportunities in spectroscopy, giving rise to ‘laser spectroscopy’ and, in photochemistry, giving rise to ‘laser photochemistry’. What follows is only an initial listing of applications of lasers to chemistry. We see throughout the text how lasers are also used in the study of macromolecules (Chapter 19) and reaction dynamics (Chapter 24). (a) Multiphoton spectroscopy The large number of photons in an incident beam generated by a laser gives rise to a qualitatively different branch of spectroscopy, for the photon density is so high that more than one photon may be absorbed by a single molecule and give rise to multiphoton processes. One application of multiphoton processes is that states inaccessible by conventional one-photon spectroscopy become observable because the overall transition occurs with no change of parity. For example, in one-photon spectroscopy, only g ↔ u transitions are observable; in two-photon spectroscopy, however, the overall outcome of absorbing two photons is a g → g or a u → u transition. (b) Raman spectroscopy Raman spectroscopy was revitalized by the introduction of lasers. An intense excitation beam increases the intensity of scattered radiation, so the use of laser sources increases the sensitivity of Raman spectroscopy. A well-defined beam also implies that the detector can be designed to collect only the radiation that has passed through a sample, and can be screened much more effectively against stray scattered light, which can obscure the Raman signal. The monochromaticity of laser radiation is also a great advantage, for it makes possible the observation of scattered light that differs by only fractions of reciprocal centimetres from the incident radiation. Such high resolution is particularly useful for observing the rotational structure of Raman lines because rotational transitions are of the order of a few reciprocal centimetres. Monochromaticity Table 14.4 Characteristics of laser radiation and their chemical applications Characteristic Advantage Application High power Multiphoton process Nonlinear spectroscopy Saturation spectroscopy Low detector noise Improved sensitivity High scattering intensity Raman spectroscopy Monochromatic High resolution Spectroscopy State selection Isotope separation Photochemically precise State-to-state reaction dynamics Collimated beam Long path lengths Sensitivitv Forward-scattering observable Nonlinear Raman spectroscopy Coherent Interference between separate beams CARS Pulsed Precise timing of excitation Fast reactions Relaxation Energy transfer 14.6 APPLICATIONS OF LASERS IN CHEMISTRY 501 also allows observations to be made very close to absorption frequencies, giving rise to the techniques of Fourier-transform Raman spectroscopy (Section 13.1) and resonance Raman spectroscopy (Section 13.16b). The availability of nondivergent beams makes possible a qualitatively different kind of spectroscopy. The beam is so well-defined that it is possible to observe Raman transitions very close to the direction of propagation of the incident beam. This configuration is employed in the technique called stimulated Raman spectroscopy. In this form of spectroscopy, the Stokes and anti-Stokes radiation in the forward direction are powerful enough to undergo more scattering and hence give up or acquire more quanta of energy from the molecules in the sample. This multiple scattering results in lines of frequency νi ± 2νM, νi ± 3νM, and so on, where νi is the frequency of the incident radiation and νM the frequency of a molecular excitation. (c) Precision-specified transitions The monochromatic character of laser radiation is a very powerful characteristic because it allows us to excite specific states with very high precision. One consequence of state-specificity for photochemistry is that the illumination of a sample may be photochemically precise and hence efficient in stimulating a reaction, because its frequency can be tuned exactly to an absorption. The specific excitation of a particular excited state of a molecule may greatly enhance the rate of a reaction even at low temperatures. The rate of a reaction is generally increased by raising the temperature because the energies of the various modes of motion of the molecule are enhanced. However, this enhancement increases the energy of all the modes, even those that do not contribute appreciably to the reaction rate. With a laser we can excite the kinetically significant mode, so rate enhancement is achieved most efficiently. An example is the reaction BCl3 + C6H6 → C6H5-BCl2 + HCl which normally proceeds only above 600°C in the presence of a catalyst; exposure to 10.6 µm CO2 laser radiation results in the formation of products at room temperature without a catalyst. The commercial potential of this procedure is considerable (provided laser photons can be produced sufficiently cheaply), because heat-sensitive compounds, such as pharmaceuticals, may perhaps be made at lower temperatures than in conventional reactions. A related application is the study of state-to-state reaction dynamics, in which a specific state of a reactant molecule is excited and we monitor not only the rate at which it forms products but also the states in which they are produced. Studies such as these give highly detailed information about the deployment of energy in chemical reactions (Chapter 24). (d) Isotope separation The precision state-selectivity of lasers is also of considerable potential for laser isotope separation. Isotope separation is possible because two isotopomers, or species that differ only in their isotopic composition, have slightly different energy levels and hence slightly different absorption frequencies. One approach is to use photoionization, the ejection of an electron by the absorption of electromagnetic radiation. Direct photoionization by the absorption of a single photon does not distinguish between isotopomers because the upper level belongs to a continuum; to distinguish isotopomers it is necessary to deal with discrete states. At least two absorption processes are required. In the first step, a photon excites an atom to a higher state; in the second step, a photon achieves photoionization from that state (Fig. 14.35). The energy separation between the two states involved in the first step Isotopomer 1 Isotopomer 2 Energy Ionization limit Fig. 14.35 In one method of isotope separation, one photon excites an isotopomer to an excited state, and then a second photon achieves photoionization. The success of the first step depends on the nuclear mass. 502 14 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 2: ELECTRONIC TRANSITIONS depends on the nuclear mass. Therefore, if the laser radiation is tuned to the appropriate frequency, only one of the isotopomers will undergo excitation and hence be available for photoionization in the second step. An example of this procedure is the photoionization of uranium vapour, in which the incident laser is tuned to excite 235 U but not 238 U. The 235 U atoms in the atomic beam are ionized in the two-step process; theyarethenattractedtoanegativelychargedelectrode,andmaybecollected(Fig.14.36). This procedure is being used in the latest generation of uranium separation plants. Molecular isotopomers are used in techniques based on photodissociation, the fragmentation of a molecule following absorption of electromagnetic radiation. The key problem is to achieve both mass selectivity (which requires excitation to take place between discrete states) and dissociation (which requires excitation to continuum states). In one approach, two lasers are used: an infrared photon excites one isotopomer selectively to a higher vibrational level, and then an ultraviolet photon completes the process of photodissociation (Fig. 14.37). An alternative procedure is to make use of multiphoton absorption within the ground electronic state (Fig. 14.38); the efficiency of absorption of the first few photons depends on the match of their frequency to the energy level separations, so it is sensitive to nuclear mass. The absorbed photons open the door to a subsequent influx of enough photons to complete the dissociation process. The isotopomers 32 SF6 and 34 SF6 have been separated in this way. In a third approach, a selectively vibrationally excited species may react with another species and give rise to products that can be separated chemically. This procedure has been employed successfully to separate isotopes of B, N, O, and, most efficiently, H. A variation on this procedure is to achieve selective photoisomerization, the conversion of a species to one of its isomers (particularly a geometrical isomer) on absorption of electromagnetic radiation. Once again, the initial absorption, which is isotope selective, opens the way to subsequent further absorption and the formation of a geometrical isomer that can be separated chemically. The approach has been used with the photoisomerization of CH3NC to CH3CN. A different, more physical approach, that of photodeflection, is based on the recoil that occurs when a photon is absorbed by an atom and the linear momentum of the photon (which is equal to h/λ) is transferred to the atom. The atom is deflected from 238 U atoms 235 U ions + + Dye laser Copper vapour laser Fig. 14.36 An experimental arrangement for isotope separation. The dye laser, which is pumped by a copper-vapour laser, photoionizes the U atoms selectively according to their mass, and the ions are deflected by the electric field applied between the plates. Molecularpotentialenergy Internuclear separation UV photon Isotopomer 1 Isotopomer 2 IR photon IR photon Fig. 14.37 Isotopomers may be separated by making use of their selective absorption of infrared photons followed by photodissociation with an ultraviolet photon. Molecularpotentialenergy Internuclear separation Isotopomer 1 Isotopomer 2 IR photon IR photon IR photons Dissociation limit Fig. 14.38 In an alternative scheme for separating isotopomers, multiphoton absorption of infrared photons is used to reach the dissociation limit of a ground electronic state. 14.6 APPLICATIONS OF LASERS IN CHEMISTRY 503 its original path only if the absorption actually occurs, and the incident radiation can be tuned to a particular isotope. The deflection is very small, so an atom must absorb dozens of photons before its path is changed sufficiently to allow collection. For instance, if a Ba atom absorbs about 50 photons of 550 nm light, it will be deflected by only about 1 mm after a flight of 1 m. (e) Time-resolved spectroscopy The ability of lasers to produce pulses of very short duration is particularly useful in chemistry when we want to monitor processes in time. Q-switched lasers produce nanosecond pulses, which are generally fast enough to study reactions with rates controlled by the speed with which reactants can move through a fluid medium. However, when we want to study the rates at which energy is converted from one mode to another within a molecule, we need femtosecond and picosecond pulses. These timescales are available from mode-locked lasers. In time-resolved spectroscopy, laser pulses are used to obtain the absorption, emission, or Raman spectrum of reactants, intermediates, products, and even transition states of reactions. It is also possible to study energy transfer, molecular rotations, vibrations, and conversion from one mode of motion to another. We shall see some of the information obtained from time-resolved spectroscopy in Chapters 22 to 24. Here, we describe some of the experimental techniques that employ pulsed lasers. The arrangement shown in Fig. 14.39 is often used to study ultrafast chemical reactions that can be initiated by light, such as the initial events of vision (Impact I14.1). A strong and short laser pulse, the pump, promotes a molecule A to an excited electronic state A* that can either emit a photon (as fluorescence or phosphorescence) or react with another species B to yield a product C: A + hν → A* (absorption) A* → A (emission) A* + B → [AB] → C (reaction) Here [AB] denotes either an intermediate or an activated complex. The rates of appearance and disappearance of the various species are determined by observing timedependent changes in the absorption spectrum of the sample during the course of the reaction. This monitoring is done by passing a weak pulse of white light, the probe, through the sample at different times after the laser pulse. Pulsed ‘white’ light can be generated directly from the laser pulse by the phenomenon of continuum generation, in which focusing an ultrafast laser pulse on a vessel containing a liquid such as water, carbon tetrachloride, CaF, or sapphire results in an outgoing beam with a wide distribution of frequencies. A time delay between the strong laser pulse and the ‘white’ light pulse can be introduced by allowing one of the beams to travel a longer distance before reaching the sample. For example, a difference in travel distance of ∆d = 3 mm corresponds to a time delay ∆t = ∆d/c ≈10 ps between two beams, where c is the speed of light. The relative distances travelled by the two beams in Fig. 14.39 are controlled by directing the ‘white’ light beam to a motorized stage carrying a pair of mirrors. Variations of the arrangement in Fig. 14.39 allow for the observation of fluorescence decay kinetics of A* and time-resolved Raman spectra during the course of the reaction. The fluorescence lifetime of A* can be determined by exciting A as before and measuring the decay of the fluorescence intensity after the pulse with a fast photodetector system. In this case, continuum generation is not necessary. Time-resolved resonance Raman spectra of A, A*, B, [AB], or C can be obtained by initiating the reaction with a strong laser pulse of a certain wavelength and then, some time later, irradiating the sample with another laser pulse that can excite the resonance Raman Laser Sample cell MonochromatorDetector Prisms on motorized stage Continuum generation Beamsplitter Lens Lens Fig. 14.39 A configuration used for timeresolved absorption spectroscopy, in which the same pulsed laser is used to generate a monochromatic pump pulse and, after continuum generation in a suitable liquid, a ‘white’ light probe pulse. The time delay between the pump and probe pulses may be varied by moving the motorized stage in the direction shown by the double arrow. 504 14 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 2: ELECTRONIC TRANSITIONS spectrum of the desired species. Also in this case continuum generation is not necessary. Instead, the Raman excitation beam may be generated in a dye laser (see Further information 14.1) or by stimulated Raman scattering of the laser pulse in a medium such as H2(g) or CH4(g). (f) Spectroscopy of single molecules There is great interest in the development of new experimental probes of very small specimens. On the one hand, our understanding of biochemical processes, such as enzymatic catalysis, protein folding, and the insertion of DNA into the cell’s nucleus, will be enhanced if it is possible to visualize individual biopolymers at work. On the other hand, techniques that can probe the structure, dynamics, and reactivity of single molecules will be needed to advance research on nanometre-sized materials (Impact I20.2). We saw in Impact I13.3 that it is possible to obtain the vibrational spectrum of samples with areas of more than 10 µm2 . Fluorescence microscopy (Impact I14.2) has also been used for many years to image biological cells, but the diffraction limit prevents the visualization of samples that are smaller than the wavelength of light used as a probe (Impact I13.3). Most molecules—including biological polymers—have dimensions that are much smaller than visible wavelengths, so special techniques had to be developed to make single-molecule spectroscopy possible. The bulk of the work done in the field of single-molecule spectroscopy is based on fluorescence microscopy with laser excitation. The laser is the radiation source of choice because it provides the high excitance required to increase the rate of arrival of photons on to the detector from small illuminated areas. Two techniques are commonly used to circumvent the diffraction limit. First, the concentration of the sample is kept so low that, on average, only one fluorescent molecule is in the illuminated area. Second, special strategies are used to illuminate very small volumes. In nearfield optical microscopy (NSOM), a very thin metal-coated optical fibre is used to deliver light to a small area. It is possible to construct fibres with tip diameters in the range of 50 to 100 nm, which are indeed smaller than visible wavelengths. The fibre tip is placed very close to the sample, in a region known as the near field, where, according to classical physics, photons do not diffract. Figure 14.40 shows the image of a 4.5 µm × 4.5 µm sample of oxazine 720 dye molecules embedded in a polymer film and obtained with NSOM by measuring the fluorescence intensity as the tip is scanned over the film surface. Each peak corresponds to a single dye molecule. In far-field confocal microscopy, laser light focused by an objective lens is used to illuminate about 1 µm3 of a very dilute sample placed beyond the near field. This illumination scheme is limited by diffraction and, as a result, data from far-field microscopy have less structural detail than data from NSOM. However, far-field microscopes are very easy to construct and the technique can be used to probe single molecules as long as there is one molecule, on average, in the illuminated area. In the wide-field epifluorescence method, a two-dimensional array detector (Further information 13.1) detects fluorescence excited by a laser and scattered scattered back from the sample (Fig. 14.41a). If the fluorescing molecules are well separated in the specimen, then it is possible to obtain a map of the distribution of fluorescent molecules in the illuminated area. For example, Fig. 14.41b shows how epifluorescence microscopy can be used to observe single molecules of the major histocompatibility (MHC) protein on the surface of a cell. Though still a relatively new technique, single-molecule spectroscopy has already been used to address important problems in chemistry and biology. Nearly all the techniques discussed in this text measure the average value of a property in a large ensemble of molecules. Single-molecule methods allow a chemist to study the nature Fig. 14.40 Image of a 4.5 µm × 4.5 µm sample of oxazine-720 dye molecules embedded in a polymer film and obtained with NSOM. Each peak corresponds to a single dye molecule. Reproduced with permission from X.S. Xie. Acc. Chem. Res. 1996, 29, 598. CHECKLIST OF KEY IDEAS 505 of distributions of physical and chemical properties in an ensemble of molecules. For example, it is possible to measure the fluorescence lifetime of a molecule by moving the laser focus to a location on the sample that contains a molecule and then measuring the decay of fluorescence intensity after excitation with a pulsed laser. Such studies have shown that not every molecule in a sample has the same fluorescence lifetime, probably because each molecule interacts with its immediate environment in a slightly different way. These details are not apparent from conventional measurements of fluorescence lifetimes, in which many molecules are excited electronically and only an average lifetime for the ensemble can be measured. Lens (a) (b) CCD From laser Optical filter Fig. 14.41 (a) Layout of an epifluorescence microscope. Laser radiation is diverted to a sample by a special optical filter that reflects radiation with a specified wavelength (in this case the laser excitation wavelength) but transmits radiation with other wavelengths (in this case, wavelengths at which the fluorescent label emits). A CCD detector (see Further information 13.1) analyses the spatial distribution of the fluorescence signal from the illuminated area. (b) Observation of fluorescence from single MHC proteins that have been labelled with a fluorescent marker and are bound to the surface of a cell (the area shown has dimensions of 12 µm × 12 µm). Image provided by Professor W.E. Moerner, Stanford University, USA. Checklist of key ideas 1. The selection rules for electronic transitions that are concerned with changes in angular momentum are: ∆Λ = 0, ±1, ∆S = 0, ∆Σ = 0, ∆Ω = 0, ±1. 2. The Laporte selection rule (for centrosymmetric molecules) states that the only allowed transitions are transitions that are accompanied by a change of parity. 3. The Franck–Condon principle states that, because the nuclei are so much more massive than the electrons, an electronic transition takes place very much faster than the nuclei can respond. 4. The intensity of an electronic transition is proportional to the Franck–Condon factor, the quantity |S(vf,vi)|2 , with S(vf,vi) = ͗vf|vi͘. 5. Examples of electronic transitions include d–d transitions in d-metal complexes, charge-transfer transitions (a transition in which an electron moves from metal to ligand or from ligand to metal in a complex), π* ← π, and π* ← n transitions. 6. A Jablonski diagram is a schematic diagram of the various types of nonradiative and radiative transitions that can occur in molecules. 7. Fluorescence is the spontaneous emission of radiation arising from a transition between states of the same multiplicity. 8. Phosphorescence is the spontaneous emission of radiation arising from a transition between states of different multiplicity. 9. Intersystem crossing is a nonradiative transition between states of different multiplicity. 10. Internal conversion is a nonradiative transition between states of the same multiplicity. 11. Laser action depends on the achievement of population inversion, an arrangement in which there are more molecules in an upper state than in a lower state, and the stimulated emission of radiation. 12. Resonant modes are the wavelengths that can be sustained by an optical cavity and contribute to the laser action. Qswitching is the modification of the resonance characteristics of the laser cavity and, consequently, of the laser output. 13. Mode locking is a technique for producing pulses of picosecond duration and less by matching the phases of many resonant cavity modes. 14. Applications of lasers in chemistry include multiphoton spectroscopy, Raman spectroscopy, precision-specified transitions, isotope separation, time-resolved spectroscopy, and single-molecule spectroscopy. 506 14 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 2: ELECTRONIC TRANSITIONS Further reading Articles and texts G. Herzberg, Molecular spectra and molecular structure I. Spectra of diatomic molecules. Krieger, Malabar (1989). G. Herzberg, Molecular spectra and molecular structure III. Electronic spectra and electronic structure of polyatomic molecules. Van Nostrand–Reinhold, New York (1966). J.R. Lakowicz, Principles of fluorescence spectroscopy. Kluwer/Plenum, New York (1999). J.C. Lindon, G.E. Tranter, and J.L. Holmes (ed.), Encyclopedia of spectroscopy and spectrometry. Academic Press, San Diego (2000). G.R. van Hecke and K.K. Karukstis, A guide to lasers in chemistry. Jones and Bartlett, Boston (1998). G. Steinmeyer, D.H. Sutter, L. Gallmann, N. Matuschek, and U. Keller, Frontiers in ultrashort pulse generation: pushing the limits in linear and nonlinear optics. Science 1999, 286, 1507. Sources of data and information M.E. Jacox, Vibrational and electronic energy levels of polyatomic transient molecules. Journal of Physical and Chemical Reference Data , Monograph No. 3 (1994). D.R. Lide (ed.), CRC Handbook of Chemistry and Physics, Sections 9 and 10, CRC Press, Boca Raton (2000). Further information Further information 14.1 Examples of practical lasers Figure 14.42 summarizes the requirements for an efficient laser. In practice, the requirements can be satisfied by using a variety of different systems, and this section reviews some that are commonly available. We also include some lasers that operate by using other than electronic transitions. Noticeably absent from this discussion are solid state lasers (including the ubiquitous diode lasers), which we discuss in Chapter 20. Comment 14.3 The web site for this text contains links to databases on the optical properties of laser materials. Efficientpumping Slowrelaxation Slow Populationinversion Fast Fast relaxation Metastable state Fig. 14.42 A summary of the features needed for efficient laser action. 1.2mm 632.8nm 3.4 mm 1 2 Ss s1 1 3 1 2 Ss s1 1 1 1 Ss2 1 Helium Neon Fig. 14.43 The transitions involved in a helium–neon laser. The pumping (of the neon) depends on a coincidental matching of the helium and neon energy separations, so excited He atoms can transfer their excess energy to Ne atoms during a collision. Gas lasers Because gas lasers can be cooled by a rapid flow of the gas through the cavity, they can be used to generate high powers. The pumping is normally achieved using a gas that is different from the gas responsible for the laser emission itself. In the helium–neon laser the active medium is a mixture of helium and neon in a mole ratio of about 5:1 (Fig. 14.43). The initial step is the excitation of an He atom to the metastable 1s1 2s1 FURTHER INFORMATION 507 configuration by using an electric discharge (the collisions of electrons and ions cause transitions that are not restricted by electricdipole selection rules). The excitation energy of this transition happens to match an excitation energy of neon, and during an He–Ne collision efficient transfer of energy may occur, leading to the production of highly excited, metastable Ne atoms with unpopulated intermediate states. Laser action generating 633 nm radiation (among about 100 other lines) then occurs. The argon-ion laser (Fig.14.44), one of a number of ‘ion lasers’, consists of argon at about 1 Torr, through which is passed an electric discharge. The discharge results in the formation of Ar+ and Ar2+ ions in excited states, which undergo a laser transition to a lower state. These ions then revert to their ground states by emitting hard ultraviolet radiation (at 72 nm), and are then neutralized by a series of electrodes in the laser cavity. One of the design problems is to find materials that can withstand this damaging residual radiation. There are many lines in the laser transition because the excited ions may make transitions to many lower states, but two strong emissions from Ar+ are at 488 nm (blue) and 514 nm (green); other transitions occur elsewhere in the visible region, in the infrared, and in the ultraviolet. The krypton-ion laser works similarly. It is less efficient, but gives a wider range of wavelengths, the most intense being at 647 nm (red), but it can also generate yellow, green, and violet lines. Both lasers are widely used in laser light shows (for this application argon and krypton are often used simultaneously in the same cavity) as well as laboratory sources of high-power radiation. The carbon dioxide laser works on a slightly different principle (Fig. 14.45), for its radiation (between 9.2 µm and 10.8 µm, with the strongest emission at 10.6 µm, in the infrared) arises from vibrational transitions. Most of the working gas is nitrogen, which becomes vibrationally excited by electronic and ionic collisions in an electric discharge. The vibrational levels happen to coincide with the ladder of antisymmetric stretch (ν3, see Fig. 13.40) energy levels of CO2, which pick up the energy during a collision. Laser action then occurs from the lowest excited level of ν3 to the lowest excited level of the symmetric stretch (ν1), which has remained unpopulated during the collisions. This transition is allowed by anharmonicities in the molecular potential energy. Some helium is included in the gas to help remove energy from this state and maintain the population inversion. In a nitrogen laser, the efficiency of the stimulated transition (at 337 nm, in the ultraviolet, the transition C3 Πu → B3 Πg) is so great that a single passage of a pulse of radiation is enough to generate laser radiation and mirrors are unnecessary: such lasers are said to be superradiant. Chemical and exciplex lasers Chemical reactions may also be used to generate molecules with nonequilibrium, inverted populations. For example, the photolysis of Cl2 leads to the formation of Cl atoms which attack H2 molecules in the mixture and produce HCl and H. The latter then attacks Cl2 to produce vibrationally excited (‘hot’) HCl molecules. Because the newly formed HCl molecules have nonequilibrium vibrational populations, laser action can result as they return to lower states. Such processes are remarkable examples of the direct conversion of chemical energy into coherent electromagnetic radiation. The population inversion needed for laser action is achieved in a more underhand way in exciplex lasers, for in these (as we shall see) the lower state does not effectively exist. This odd situation is achieved by forming an exciplex, a combination of two atoms that survives only in an excited state and which dissociates as soon as the excitation energy has been discarded. An exciplex can be formed in a mixture of xenon, chlorine, and neon (which acts as a buffer gas). An electric discharge through the mixture produces excited Cl atoms, which attach to the Xe atoms to give the exciplex XeCl*. The exciplex survives for about 10 ns, which is time for it to participate in laser action at 308 nm (in the ultraviolet). As soon as XeCl* has discarded a 454 nm to 514 nm Ar + Ar+ Ar + Radiative, 72nm Ar Fig. 14.44 The transitions involved in an argon-ion laser. Antisymmetricstretch Symmetricstretch Bend N2 CO2 3 1 23 2 1 0 10.6 mm n n n Fig. 14.45 The transitions involved in a carbon dioxide laser. The pumping also depends on the coincidental matching of energy separations; in this case the vibrationally excited N2 molecules have excess energies that correspond to a vibrational excitation of the antisymmetric stretch of CO2. The laser transition is from ν3 = 1 to ν1 = 1. 508 14 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 2: ELECTRONIC TRANSITIONS photon, the atoms separate because the molecular potential energy curve of the ground state is dissociative, and the ground state of the exciplex cannot become populated (Fig. 14.46). The KrF* exciplex laser is another example: it produces radiation at 249 nm. Comment 14.4 The term ‘excimer laser’ is also widely encountered and used loosely when ‘exciplex laser’ is more appropriate. An exciplex has the form AB* whereas an excimer, an excited dimer, is AA*. Dye lasers Gas lasers and most solid state lasers operate at discrete frequencies and, although the frequency required may be selected by suitable optics, the laser cannot be tuned continuously. The tuning problem is overcome by using a titanium sapphire laser (see above) or a dye laser, which has broad spectral characteristics because the solvent broadens the vibrational structure of the transitions into bands. Hence, it is possible to scan the wavelength continuously (by rotating the diffraction grating in the cavity) and achieve laser action at any chosen wavelength. A commonly used dye is rhodamine 6G in methanol (Fig. 14.47). As the gain is very high, only a short length of Exciplex, AB* Dissociative state, AB Laser transition Molecularpotentialenergy A B distanceFig. 14.46 The molecular potential energy curves for an exciplex. The species can survive only as an excited state, because on discarding its energy it enters the lower, dissociative state. Because only the upper state can exist, there is never any population in the lower state. 300 400 500 600 /nm Absorption Fluorescence 1 /(10dmmolcm) 5311 Laser region l e-- Fig. 14.47 The optical absorption spectrum of the dye Rhodamine 6G and the region used for laser action. Pumping radiation Cavity mirror Cavity mirror Pump mirror Tuner Output mirror Dye stream Dye cell Fig. 14.48 The configuration used for a dye laser. The dye is flowed through the cell inside the laser cavity. The flow helps to keep it cool and prevents degradation. Discussion questions 14.1 Explain the origin of the term symbol 3 Σg − for the ground state of dioxygen. 14.2 Explain the basis of the Franck–Condon principle and how it leads to the formation of a vibrational progression. 14.3 How do the band heads in P and R branches arise? Could the Q branch show a head? 14.4 Explain how colour can arise from molecules. 14.5 Describe the mechanism of fluorescence. To what extent is a fluorescence spectrum not the exact mirror image of the corresponding absorption spectrum? 14.6 What is the evidence for the correctness of the mechanism of fluorescence? 14.7 Describe the principles of laser action, with actual examples. 14.8 What features of laser radiation are applied in chemistry? Discuss two applications of lasers in chemistry. the optical path need be through the dye. The excited states of the active medium, the dye, are sustained by another laser or a flash lamp, and the dye solution is flowed through the laser cavity to avoid thermal degradation (Fig. 14.48). EXERCISES 509 max Molarabsorptioncoefficient, Wavenumber, ~ ( ) {1 ( ) }= - -max max 2~ ~ ~ max ~ n n ne e k e e n n Exercises 14.1a The term symbol for the ground state of N2 + is 2 Σg + . What is the total spin and total orbital angular momentum of the molecule? Show that the term symbol agrees with the electron configuration that would be predicted using the building-up principle. 14.1b One of the excited states of the C2 molecule has the valence electron configuration 1σg 2 1σu 2 1πu 3 1πg 1 . Give the multiplicity and parity of the term. 14.2a The molar absorption coefficient of a substance dissolved in hexane is known to be 855 dm3 mol−1 cm−1 at 270 nm. Calculate the percentage reduction in intensity when light of that wavelength passes through 2.5 mm of a solution of concentration 3.25 mmol dm−3 . 14.2b The molar absorption coefficient of a substance dissolved in hexane is known to be 327 dm3 mol−1 cm−1 at 300 nm. Calculate the percentage reduction in intensity when light of that wavelength passes through 1.50 mm of a solution of concentration 2.22 mmol dm−3 . 14.3a A solution of an unknown component of a biological sample when placed in an absorption cell of path length 1.00 cm transmits 20.1 per cent of light of 340 nm incident upon it. If the concentration of the component is 0.111 mmol dm−3 , what is the molar absorption coefficient? 14.3b When light of wavelength 400 nm passes through 3.5 mm of a solution of an absorbing substance at a concentration 0.667 mmol dm−3 , the transmission is 65.5 per cent. Calculate the molar absorption coefficient of the solute at this wavelength and express the answer in cm2 mol−1 . 14.4a The molar absorption coefficient of a solute at 540 nm is 286 dm3 mol−1 cm−1 . When light of that wavelength passes through a 6.5 mm cell containing a solution of the solute, 46.5 per cent of the light is absorbed. What is the concentration of the solution? 14.4b The molar absorption coefficient of a solute at 440 nm is 323 dm3 mol−1 cm−1 . When light of that wavelength passes through a 7.50 mm cell containing a solution of the solute, 52.3 per cent of the light is absorbed. What is the concentration of the solution? 14.5a The absorption associated with a particular transition begins at 230 nm, peaks sharply at 260 nm, and ends at 290 nm. The maximum value of the molar absorption coefficient is 1.21 × 104 dm3 mol−1 cm−1 . Estimate the integrated absorption coefficient of the transition assuming a triangular lineshape (see eqn 13.5). 14.5b The absorption associated with a certain transition begins at 199 nm, peaks sharply at 220 nm, and ends at 275 nm. The maximum value of the molar absorption coefficient is 2.25 × 104 dm3 mol−1 cm−1 . Estimate the integrated absorption coefficient of the transition assuming an inverted parabolic lineshape (Fig. 14.49; use eqn 13.5). 14.6a The two compounds, 2,3-dimethyl-2-butene and 2,5-dimethyl-2,4hexadiene, are to be distinguished by their ultraviolet absorption spectra. The maximum absorption in one compound occurs at 192 nm and in the other at 243 nm. Match the maxima to the compounds and justify the assignment. 14.6b 1,3,5-hexatriene (a kind of ‘linear’ benzene) was converted into benzene itself. On the basis of a free-electron molecular orbital model (in which hexatriene is treated as a linear box and benzene as a ring), would you expect the lowest energy absorption to rise or fall in energy? 14.7a The following data were obtained for the absorption by Br2 in carbon tetrachloride using a 2.0 mm cell. Calculate the molar absorption coefficient of bromine at the wavelength employed: [Br2]/(mol dm−3 ) 0.0010 0.0050 0.0100 0.0500 T/(per cent) 81.4 35.6 12.7 3.0 × 10−3 14.7b The following data were obtained for the absorption by a dye dissolved in methylbenzene using a 2.50 mm cell. Calculate the molar absorption coefficient of the dye at the wavelength employed: [dye]/(mol dm−3 ) 0.0010 0.0050 0.0100 0.0500 T/(per cent) 73 21 4.2 1.33 × 10−5 14.8a A 2.0-mm cell was filled with a solution of benzene in a non-absorbing solvent. The concentration of the benzene was 0.010 mol dm−3 and the wavelength of the radiation was 256 nm (where there is a maximum in the absorption). Calculate the molar absorption coefficient of benzene at this wavelength given that the transmission was 48 per cent. What will the transmittance be in a 4.0-mm cell at the same wavelength? 14.8b A 2.50-mm cell was filled with a solution of a dye. The concentration of the dye was 15.5 mmol dm−3 . Calculate the molar absorption coefficient of benzene at this wavelength given that the transmission was 32 per cent. What will the transmittance be in a 4.50-mm cell at the same wavelength? 14.9a A swimmer enters a gloomier world (in one sense) on diving to greater depths. Given that the mean molar absorption coefficient of sea water in the visible region is 6.2 × 10−3 dm3 mol−1 cm−1 , calculate the depth at which a diver will experience (a) half the surface intensity of light, (b) one tenth the surface intensity. 14.9b Given that the maximum molar absorption coefficient of a molecule containing a carbonyl group is 30 dm3 mol−1 cm−1 near 280 nm, calculate the thickness of a sample that will result in (a) half the initial intensity of radiation, (b) one-tenth the initial intensity. 14.10a The electronic absorption bands of many molecules in solution have half-widths at half-height of about 5000 cm−1 . Estimate the integrated absorption coefficients of bands for which (a) εmax ≈ 1 × 104 dm3 mol−1 cm−1 , (b) εmax ≈ 5 × 102 dm3 mol−1 cm−1 . 14.10b The electronic absorption band of a compound in solution had a Gaussian lineshape and a half-width at half-height of 4233 cm−1 and εmax = 1.54 × 104 dm3 mol−1 cm−1 . Estimate the integrated absorption coefficient. 14.11a The photoionization of H2 by 21 eV photons produces H2 + . Explain why the intensity of the v = 2 ← 0 transition is stronger than that of the 0 ← 0 transition. 14.11b The photoionization of F2 by 21 eV photons produces F2 + . Would you expect the 2 ← 0 transition to be weaker or stronger than the 0 ← 0 transition? Justify your answer. Fig. 14.49 510 14 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 2: ELECTRONIC TRANSITIONS Problems* Numerical problems 14.1 The vibrational wavenumber of the oxygen molecule in its electronic ground state is 1580 cm−1 , whereas that in the first excited state (B 3 Σu − ), to which there is an allowed electronic transition, is 700 cm−1 . Given that the separation in energy between the minima in their respective potential energy curves of these two electronic states is 6.175 eV, what is the wavenumber of the lowest energy transition in the band of transitions originating from the v = 0 vibrational state of the electronic ground state to this excited state? Ignore any rotational structure or anharmonicity. 14.2 A Birge–Sponer extrapolation yields 7760 cm−1 as the area under the curve for the B state of the oxygen molecule described in Problem 14.1. Given that the B state dissociates to ground-state atoms (at zero energy, 3 P) and 15 870 cm−1 (1 D) and the lowest vibrational state of the B state is 49 363 cm−1 above the lowest vibrational state of the ground electronic state, calculate the dissociation energy of the molecular ground state to the ground-state atoms. 14.3 The electronic spectrum of the IBr molecule shows two low-lying, well defined convergence limits at 14 660 and 18 345 cm−1 . Energy levels for the iodine and bromine atoms occur at 0, 7598; and 0, 3685 cm−1 , respectively. Other atomic levels are at much higher energies. What possibilities exist for the numerical value of the dissociation energy of IBr? Decide which is the correct possibility by calculating this quantity from ∆fH7 (IBr, g) = +40.79 kJ mol−1 and the dissociation energies of I2(g) and Br2(g) which are 146 and 190 kJ mol−1 , respectively. 14.4 In many cases it is possible to assume that an absorption band has a Gaussian lineshape (one proportional to e−x2 ) centred on the band maximum. Assume such a line shape, and show that A ≈ 1.0645εmax∆#1/2, where ∆#1/2 is the width at half-height. The absorption spectrum of azoethane (CH3CH2N2) between 24 000 cm−1 and 34 000 cm−1 is shown in Fig. 14.50. First, estimate A for the band by assuming that it is Gaussian. Then integrate the absorption band graphically. The latter can be done either by ruling and counting squares, or by tracing the lineshape on to paper and weighing. A more sophisticated procedure would be to use mathematical software to fit a polynomial to the absorption band (or a Gaussian), and then to integrate the result analytically. 14.5 A lot of information about the energy levels and wavefunctions of small inorganic molecules can be obtained from their ultraviolet spectra. An example of a spectrum with considerable vibrational structure, that of gaseous SO2 at 25°C, is shown in Fig. 14.6. Estimate the integrated absorption coefficient for the transition. transition. What electronic states are accessible from the A1 ground state of this Cv molecule by electric dipole transitions? 14.6‡ J.G. Dojahn, E.C.M. Chen, and W.E. Wentworth (J. Phys. Chem. 100, 9649 (1996)) characterized the potential energy curves of the ground and electronic states of homonuclear diatomic halogen anions. These anions have a 2 Σu + ground state and 2 Πg, 2 Πu, and 2 Σg + excited states. To which of the excited states are transitions by absorption of photons allowed? Explain. 14.7 A transition of particular importance in O2 gives rise to the ‘Schumann–Runge band’ in the ultraviolet region. The wavenumbers (in cm−1 ) of transitions from the ground state to the vibrational levels of the first excited state (3 Σu − ) are 50 062.6, 50 725.4, 51 369.0, 51 988.6, 52 579.0, 53 143.4, 53 679.6, 54 177.0, 54 641.8, 55 078.2, 55 460.0, 55 803.1, 56 107.3, 56 360.3, 56 570.6. What is the dissociation energy of the upper electronic state? (Use a Birge–Sponer plot.) The same excited state is known to dissociate into one ground-state O atom and one excited-state atom with an energy 190 kJ mol−1 above the ground state. (This excited atom is responsible for a great deal of photochemical mischief in the atmosphere.) Ground-state O2 dissociates into two ground-state atoms. Use this information to calculate the dissociation energy of ground-state O2 from the Schumann–Runge data. 14.8 The compound CH3CH=CHCHO has a strong absorption in the ultraviolet at 46 950 cm−1 and a weak absorption at 30 000 cm−1 . Justify these features in terms of the structure of the molecule. 14.9 Aromatic hydrocarbons and I2 form complexes from which chargetransfer electronic transitions are observed. The hydrocarbon acts as an electron donor and I2 as an electron acceptor. The energies hνmax of the charge-transfer transitions for a number of hydrocarbon–I2 complexes are given below: Hydrocarbon benzene biphenyl naphthalene phenanthrene pyrene anthracene hνmax/eV 4.184 3.654 3.452 3.288 2.989 2.890 Investigate the hypothesis that there is a correlation between the energy of the HOMO of the hydrocarbon (from which the electron comes in the charge–transfer transition) and hνmax. Use one of the molecular electronic structure methods discussed in Chapter 11 to determine the energy of the HOMO of each hydrocarbon in the data set.1 14.10 A certain molecule fluoresces at a wavelength of 400 nm with a half-life of 1.0 ns. It phosphoresces at 500 nm. If the ratio of the transition probabilities for stimulated emission for the S* → S to the T → S transitions is 1.0 × 105 , what is the half-life of the phosphorescent state? 14.11 Consider some of the precautions that must be taken when conducting single-molecule spectroscopy experiments. (a) What is the molar concentration of a solution in which there is, on average, one solute molecule in 1.0 µm3 (1.0 fL) of solution? (b) It is important to use pure solvents in single-molecule spectroscopy because optical signals from fluorescent * Problems denoted with the symbol ‡ were supplied by Charles Trapp and Carmen Giunta. 1 The web site contains links to molecular modelling freeware and to other sites where you may perform molecular orbital calculations directly from your web browser. 22000 26000 30000 34000 10 8 6 4 2 0 /(dmmolcm) 311 /cm 1~n e -- Fig. 14.50 PROBLEMS 511 impurities in the solvent may mask optical signals from the solute. Suppose that water containing a fluorescent impurity of molar mass 100 g mol−1 is used as solvent and that analysis indicates the presence of 0.10 mg of impurity per 1.0 kg of solvent. On average, how many impurity molecules will be present in 1.0 µm3 of solution? You may take the density of water as 1.0 g cm−3 . Comment on the suitability of this solvent for single-molecule spectroscopy experiments. 14.12 Light-induced degradation of molecules, also called photobleaching, is a serious problem in single-molecule spectroscopy. A molecule of a fluorescent dye commonly used to label biopolymers can withstand about 106 excitations by photons before light-induced reactions destroy its π system and the molecule no longer fluoresces. For how long will a single dye molecule fluoresce while being excited by 1.0 mW of 488 nm radiation from a continuous-wave argon ion laser? You may assume that the dye has an absorption spectrum that peaks at 488 nm and that every photon delivered by the laser is absorbed by the molecule. Theoretical problems 14.13 Assume that the electronic states of the π electrons of a conjugated molecule can be approximated by the wavefunctions of a particle in a onedimensional box, and that the dipole moment can be related to the displacement along this length by µ = −ex. Show that the transition probability for the transition n = 1 → n = 2 is nonzero, whereas that for n = 1 → n = 3 is zero. Hint. The following relations will be useful: sin x sin y = 1 –2 cos(x − y) − 1 –2 cos(x + y) Ύx cos ax dx = cos ax + sin ax 14.14 Use a group theoretical argument to decide which of the following transitions are electric-dipole allowed: (a) the π* ← π transition in ethene, (b) the π* ← n transition in a carbonyl group in a C2v environment. 14.15 Suppose that you are a colour chemist and had been asked to intensify the colour of a dye without changing the type of compound, and that the dye in question was a polyene. Would you choose to lengthen or to shorten the chain? Would the modification to the length shift the apparent colour of the dye towards the red or the blue? 14.16 One measure of the intensity of a transition of frequency ν is the oscillator strength, f, which is defined as f = Consider an electron in an atom to be oscillating harmonically in one dimension (the three-dimensional version of this model was used in early attempts to describe atomic structure). The wavefunctions for such an electron are those in Table 9.1. Show that the oscillator strength for the transition of this electron from its ground state is exactly 1 –3. 14.17 Estimate the oscillator strength (see Problem 14.16) of a chargetransfer transition modelled as the migration of an electron from an H1s orbital on one atom to another H1s orbital on an atom a distance R away. Approximate the transition moment by −eRS where S is the overlap integral of the two orbitals. Sketch the oscillator strength as a function of R using the curve for S given in Fig. 11.29. Why does the intensity fall to zero as R approaches 0 and infinity? 14.18 The line marked A in Fig. 14.51 is the fluorescence spectrum of benzophenone in solid solution in ethanol at low temperatures observed when the sample is illuminated with 360 nm light. What can be said about the vibrational energy levels of the carbonyl group in (a) its ground electronic state and (b) its excited electronic state? When naphthalene is illuminated with 360 nm light it does not absorb, but the line marked B in 8π2 meν|µfi|2 3he2 x a 1 a2 the illustration is the phosphorescence spectrum of a solid solution of a mixture of naphthalene and benzophenone in ethanol. Now a component of fluorescence from naphthalene can be detected. Account for this observation. 14.19 The fluorescence spectrum of anthracene vapour shows a series of peaks of increasing intensity with individual maxima at 440 nm, 410 nm, 390 nm, and 370 nm followed by a sharp cut-off at shorter wavelengths. The absorption spectrum rises sharply from zero to a maximum at 360 nm with a trail of peaks of lessening intensity at 345 nm, 330 nm, and 305 nm. Account for these observations. 14.20 The Beer–Lambert law states that the absorbance of a sample at a wavenumber # is proportional to the molar concentration [J] of the absorbing species J and to the length l of the sample (eqn 13.4). In this problem you will show that the intensity of fluorescence emission from a sample of J is also proportional to [J] and l. Consider a sample of J that is illuminated with a beam of intensity I0(#) at the wavenumber #. Before fluorescence can occur, a fraction of I0(#) must be absorbed and an intensity I(#) will be transmitted. However, not all of the absorbed intensity is emitted and the intensity of fluorescence depends on the fluorescence quantum yield, φf, the efficiency of photon emission. The fluorescence quantum yield ranges from 0 to 1 and is proportional to the ratio of the integral of the fluorescence spectrum over the integrated absorption coefficient. Because of a Stokes shift of magnitude ∆#Stokes, fluorescence occurs at a wavenumber #f, with #f + ∆#Stokes = #. It follows that the fluorescence intensity at #f, If(#f), is proportional to φf and to the intensity of exciting radiation that is absorbed by J, Iabs(#) = I0(#) − I(#). (a) Use the Beer–Lambert law to express Iabs(#) in terms of I0(#), [J], l, and ε(#), the molar absorption coefficient of J at #. (b) Use your result from part (a) to show that If(#f) ∝ I0(#)ε(#)φf[J]l. 14.21 Spin angular momentum is conserved when a molecule dissociates into atoms. What atom multiplicities are permitted when (a) an O2 molecule, (b) an N2 molecule dissociates into atoms? Applications: to biochemistry, environmental science, and astrophysics 14.22 The protein haemerythrin (Her) is responsible for binding and carrying O2 in some invertebrates. Each protein molecule has two Fe2+ ions that are in very close proximity and work together to bind one molecule of O2. The Fe2O2 group of oxygenated haemerythrin is coloured and has an electronic absorption band at 500 nm. Figure 14.52 shows the UV-visible absorption spectrum of a derivative of haemerythrin in the presence of different concentrations of CNS− ions. What may be inferred from the spectrum? Emissionintensity A B 15000 20000 25000 /cm 1~n Fig. 14.51 14.26‡ The abundance of ozone is typically inferred from measurements of UV absorption and is often expressed in terms of Dobson units (DU): 1 DU is equivalent to a layer of pure ozone 10−3 cm thick at 1 atm and 0°C. Compute the absorbance of UV radiation at 300 nm expected for an ozone abundance of 300 DU (a typical value) and 100 DU (a value reached during seasonal Antarctic ozone depletions) given a molar absorption coefficient of 476 dm3 mol−1 cm−1 . 14.27‡ G.C.G. Wachewsky, R. Horansky, and V. Vaida (J. Phys. Chem. 100, 11559 (1996)) examined the UV absorption spectrum of CH3I, a species of interest in connection with stratospheric ozone chemistry. They found the integrated absorption coefficient to be dependent on temperature and pressure to an extent inconsistent with internal structural changes in isolated CH3I molecules; they explained the changes as due to dimerization of a substantial fraction of the CH3I, a process that would naturally be pressure and temperature dependent. (a) Compute the integrated absorption coefficient over a triangular lineshape in the range 31 250 to 34 483 cm−1 and a maximal molar absorption coefficient of 150 dm3 mol−1 cm−1 at 31 250 cm−1 . (b) Suppose 1 per cent of the CH3I units in a sample at 2.4 Torr and 373 K exists as dimers. Compute the absorbance expected at 31 250 cm−1 in a sample cell of length 12.0 cm. (c) Suppose 18 per cent of the CH3I units in a sample at 100 Torr and 373 K exists as dimers. Compute the absorbance expected at 31 250 cm−1 in a sample cell of length 12.0 cm; compute the molar absorption coefficient that would be inferred from this absorbance if dimerization was not considered. 14.28‡ The molecule Cl2O2 is believed to participate in the seasonal depletion of ozone over Antarctica. M. Schwell, H.-W. Jochims, B. Wassermann, U. Rockland, R. Flesch, and E. Rühl (J. Phys. Chem. 100, 10070 (1996)) measured the ionization energies of Cl2O2 by photoelectron spectroscopy in which the ionized fragments were detected using a mass spectrometer. From their data, we can infer that the ionization enthalpy of Cl2O2 is 11.05 eV and the enthalpy of the dissociative ionization Cl2O2 → Cl + OClO+ + e− is 10.95 eV. They used this information to make some inferences about the structure of Cl2O2. Computational studies had suggested that the lowest energy isomer is ClOOCl, but that ClClO2 (C2v) and ClOClO are not very much higher in energy. The Cl2O2 in the photoionization step is the lowest energy isomer, whatever its structure may be, and its enthalpy of formation had previously been reported as +133 kJ mol−1 . The Cl2O2 in the dissociative ionization step is unlikely to be ClOOCl, for the product can be derived from it only with substantial rearrangement. Given ∆fH7 (OClO+ ) = +1096 kJ mol−1 and ∆fH7 (e− ) = 0, determine whether the Cl2O2 in the dissociative ionization is the same as that in the photoionization. If different, how much greater is its ∆fH7 ? Are these results consistent with or contradictory to the computational studies? 14.29‡ One of the principal methods for obtaining the electronic spectra of unstable radicals is to study the spectra of comets, which are almost entirely due to radicals. Many radical spectra have been found in comets, including that due to CN. These radicals are produced in comets by the absorption of far ultraviolet solar radiation by their parent compounds. Subsequently, their fluorescence is excited by sunlight of longer wavelength. The spectra of comet Hale–Bopp (C/1995 O1) have been the subject of many recent studies. One such study is that of the fluorescence spectrum of CN in the comet at large heliocentric distances by R.M. Wagner and D.G. Schleicher (Science 275, 1918 (1997)), in which the authors determine the spatial distribution and rate of production of CN in the coma. The (0–0) vibrational band is centred on 387.6 nm and the weaker (1–1) band with relative intensity 0.1 is centred on 386.4 nm. The band heads for (0–0) and (0–1) are known to be 388.3 and 421.6 nm, respectively. From these data, calculate the energy of the excited S1 state relative to the ground S0 state, the vibrational wavenumbers and the difference in the vibrational wavenumbers of the two states, and the relative populations of the v = 0 and v = 1 vibrational levels of the S1 state. Also estimate the effective temperature of the molecule in the excited S1 state. Only eight rotational levels of the S1 state are thought to be populated. Is that observation consistent with the effective temperature of the S1 state? 512 14 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 2: ELECTRONIC TRANSITIONS 14.23 The flux of visible photons reaching Earth from the North Star is about 4 × 103 mm−2 s−1 . Of these photons, 30 per cent are absorbed or scattered by the atmosphere and 25 per cent of the surviving photons are scattered by the surface of the cornea of the eye. A further 9 per cent are absorbed inside the cornea. The area of the pupil at night is about 40 mm2 and the response time of the eye is about 0.1 s. Of the photons passing through the pupil, about 43 per cent are absorbed in the ocular medium. How many photons from the North Star are focused on to the retina in 0.1 s? For a continuation of this story, see R.W. Rodieck, The first steps in seeing, Sinauer, Sunderland (1998). 14.24 Use molecule (7) as a model of the trans conformation of the chromophore found in rhodopsin. In this model, the methyl group bound to the nitrogen atom of the protonated Schiff’s base replaces the protein. (a) Using molecular modelling software and the computational method of your instructor’s choice, calculate the energy separation between the HOMO and LUMO of (7). (b) Repeat the calculation for the 11-cis form of (7). (c) Based on your results from parts (a) and (b), do you expect the experimental frequency for the π* ← π visible absorption of the trans form of (7) to be higher or lower than that for the 11-cis form of (7)? 14.25‡ Ozone absorbs ultraviolet radiation in a part of the electromagnetic spectrum energetic enough to disrupt DNA in biological organisms and that is absorbed by no other abundant atmospheric constituent. This spectral range, denoted UV-B, spans the wavelengths of about 290 nm to 320 nm. The molar extinction coefficient of ozone over this range is given in the table below (W.B. DeMore, S.P. Sander, D.M. Golden, R.F. Hampson, M.J. Kurylo, C.J. Howard, A.R. Ravishankara, C.E. Kolb, and M.J. Molina, Chemical kinetics and photochemical data for use in stratospheric modeling: Evaluation Number 11, JPL Publication 94–26 (1994). λ/nm 292.0 296.3 300.8 305.4 310.1 315.0 320.0 ε/(dm3 mol−1 cm−1 ) 1512 865 477 257 135.9 69.5 34.5 Compute the integrated absorption coefficient of ozone over the wavelength range 290–320 nm. (Hint. ε(#) can be fitted to an exponential function quite well.) Her(OH)8 Her(CNS)8 Absorbance Wavenumber, ~n Fig. 14.52 Molecular spectroscopy 3: magnetic resonance One of the most widely used spectroscopic procedures in chemistry makes use of the classical concept of resonance. The chapter begins with an account of conventional nuclear magnetic resonance, which shows how the resonance frequency of a magnetic nucleus is affected by its electronic environment and the presence of magnetic nuclei in its vicinity. Then we turn to the modern versions of NMR, which are based on the use of pulses of electromagnetic radiation and the processing of the resulting signal by Fourier transform techniques. The experimental techniques for electron paramagnetic resonance resemble those used in the early days of NMR. The information obtained is very useful for the determination of the properties of species with unpaired electrons. When two pendulums share a slightly flexible support and one is set in motion, the other is forced into oscillation by the motion of the common axle. As a result, energy flows between the two pendulums. The energy transfer occurs most efficiently when the frequencies of the two pendulums are identical. The condition of strong effective coupling when the frequencies of two oscillators are identical is called resonance. Resonance is the basis of a number of everyday phenomena, including the response of radios to the weak oscillations of the electromagnetic field generated by a distant transmitter. In this chapter we explore some spectroscopic applications that, as originally developed (and in some cases still), depend on matching a set of energy levels to a source of monochromatic radiation and observing the strong absorption that occurs at resonance. The effect of magnetic fields on electrons and nuclei The Stern–Gerlach experiment (Section 9.8) provided evidence for electron spin. It turns out that many nuclei also possess spin angular momentum. Orbital and spin angular momenta give rise to magnetic moments, and to say that electrons and nuclei have magnetic moments means that, to some extent, they behave like small bar magnets. First, we establish how the energies of electrons and nuclei depend on the strength of an external field. Then we see how to use this dependence to study the structure and dynamics of complex molecules. 15.1 The energies of electrons in magnetic fields Classically, the energy of a magnetic moment m in a magnetic field ; is equal to the scalar product 15 The effect of magnetic fields on electrons and nuclei 15.1 The energies of electrons in magnetic fields 15.2 The energies of nuclei in magnetic fields 15.3 Magnetic resonance spectroscopy Nuclear magnetic resonance 15.4 The NMR spectrometer 15.5 The chemical shift 15.6 The fine structure 15.7 Conformational conversion and exchange processes Pulse techniques in NMR 15.8 The magnetization vector 15.9 Spin relaxation I15.1 Impact on medicine: Magnetic resonance imaging 15.10 Spin decoupling 15.11 The nuclear Overhauser effect 15.12 Two-dimensional NMR 15.13 Solid-state NMR Electron paramagnetic resonance 15.14 The EPR spectrometer 15.15 The g-value 15.16 Hyperfine structure I15.2 Impact on biochemistry: Spin probes Checklist of key ideas Further reading Further information 15.1: Fourier transformation of the FID curve Discussion questions Exercises Problems 514 15 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 3: MAGNETIC RESONANCE E = −m·; (15.1) Quantum mechanically, we write the hamiltonian as @ = −¢·; (15.2) To write an expression for ¢, we recall from Section 9.8 that the magnetic moment is proportional to the angular momentum. For an electron possessing orbital angular momentum we write ¢ = γe™ and @ = −γe ;·™ (15.3) where ™ is the orbital angular momentum operator and γe = − (15.4) γe is called the magnetogyric ratio of the electron: The negative sign (arising from the sign of the electron’s charge) shows that the orbital moment is antiparallel to its orbital angular momentum (as was depicted in Fig 10.26). For a magnetic field B0 along the z-direction, eqn 15.3 becomes Nz = γeZz and @ = −γeB0Zz = −NzB0 (15.5a) Because the eigenvalues of the operator ™z are ml$, the z-component of the orbital magnetic moment and the energy of interaction are, respectively, µz = γeml$ and E = −γeml$B0 = mlµBB0 (15.5b) where the Bohr magneton, µB, is µB = −γe$ = = 9.724 × 10−24 J T−1 [15.6] The Bohr magneton is often regarded as the fundamental quantum of magnetic moment. The spin magnetic moment of an electron, which has a spin quantum number s = 1 –2 (Section 9.8), is also proportional to its spin angular momentum. However, instead of eqn 15.3, the spin magnetic moment and hamiltonian operators are, respectively, ¢ = geγe£ and @ = −geγe;·£ (15.7) where £ is the spin angular momentum operator and the extra factor ge is called the g-value of the electron: ge = 2.002 319. . . . The g-value arises from relativistic effects and from interactions of the electron with the electromagnetic fluctuations of the vacuum that surrounds the electron. For a magnetic field B0 in the z-direction, Nz = geγeSz and @ = −geγeB0Sz (15.8a) Because the eigenvalues of the operator Sz are ms$ with ms = +1 –2(α) and ms = −1 –2(β), it follows that the energies of an electron spin in a magnetic field are µz = geγems$ and Ems = −geγems$B0 = geµBmsB0 (15.8b) with ms = ±1 –2. In the absence of a magnetic field, the states with different values of ml and ms are degenerate. When a field is present, the degeneracy is removed: the state with ms = +1 –2 moves up in energy by 1 –2geµBB0 and the state with ms = −1 –2 moves down by 1 –2geµBB0. The different energies arising from an interaction with an external field are sometimes represented on the vector model by picturing the vectors as precessing, or sweeping e$ 2me e 2me Comment 15.1 More formally, ; is the magnetic induction and is measured in tesla, T; 1 T = 1 kg s−2 A−1 . The (non-SI) unit gauss, G, is also occasionally used: 1 T = 104 G. Comment 15.2 The scalar product (or ‘dot product’) of two vectors a and b is given by a·b = ab cos q, where a and b are the magnitudes of a and b, respectively, and q is the angle between them. 15.2 THE ENERGIES OF NUCLEI IN MAGNETIC FIELDS 515 round their cones (Fig. 15.1), with the rate of precession equal to the Larmor frequency, νL: νL = (15.9) Equation 15.9 shows that the Larmor frequency increases with the strength of the magnetic field. For a field of 1 T, the Larmor frequency is 30 GHz. 15.2 The energies of nuclei in magnetic fields The spin quantum number, I, of a nucleus is a fixed characteristic property of a nucleus and is either an integer or a half-integer (Table 15.1). A nucleus with spin quantum number I has the following properties: 1. An angular momentum of magnitude {I(I + 1)}1/2 $. 2. A component of angular momentum mI$ on a specified axis (‘the z-axis’), where mI = I, I − 1, . . . , −I. 3. If I > 0, a magnetic moment with a constant magnitude and an orientation that is determined by the value of mI. According to the second property, the spin, and hence the magnetic moment, of the nucleus may lie in 2I + 1 different orientations relative to an axis. A proton has I = 1 –2 and its spin may adopt either of two orientations; a 14 N nucleus has I = 1 and its spin may adopt any of three orientations; both 12 C and 16 O have I = 0 and hence zero magnetic moment. The energy of interaction between a nucleus with a magnetic moment m and an external magnetic field ; may be calculated by using operators analogous to those of eqn 15.3: ¢ = γÎ and H = −γ;·Î (15.10a) where γ is the magnetogyric ratio of the specified nucleus, an empirically determined characteristic arising from the internal structure of the nucleus (Table 15.2). The corresponding energies are EmI = −µzB0 = −γ$B0mI (15.10b) As for electrons, the nuclear spin may be pictured as precessing around the direction of the applied field at a rate proportional to the applied field. For protons, a field of 1 T corresponds to a Larmor frequency (eqn 15.9, with γe replaced by γ) of about 40 MHz. γeB0 2π ms = + ms = - z -2 1 -2 1 Fig. 15.1 The interactions between the ms states of an electron and an external magnetic field may be visualized as the precession of the vectors representing the angular momentum. Table 15.1 Nuclear constitution and the nuclear spin quantum number* Number of protons Number of neutrons I even even 0 odd odd integer (1, 2, 3, . . .) even odd half-integer (1 –2, 3 –2, 5 –2, . . .) odd even half-integer (1 –2, 3 –2, 5 –2, . . .) * The spin of a nucleus may be different if it is in an excited state; throughout this chapter we deal only with the ground state of nuclei. 516 15 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 3: MAGNETIC RESONANCE The magnetic moment of a nucleus is sometimes expressed in terms of the nuclear g-factor, gI, a characteristic of the nucleus, and the nuclear magneton, µN, a quantity independent of the nucleus, by using γ$ = gIµN µN = = 5.051 × 10−27 J T−1 [15.11] where mp is the mass of the proton. Nuclear g-factors vary between −6 and +6 (see Table 15.2): positive values of gI and γ denote a magnetic moment that is parallel to the spin; negative values indicate that the magnetic moment and spin are antiparallel. For the remainder of this chapter we shall assume that γ is positive, as is the case for the majority of nuclei. In such cases, the states with negative values of mI lie above states with positive values of mI. The nuclear magneton is about 2000 times smaller than the Bohr magneton, so nuclear magnetic moments—and consequently the energies of interaction with magnetic fields—are about 2000 times weaker than the electron spin magnetic moment. 15.3 Magnetic resonance spectroscopy In its original form, the magnetic resonance experiment is the resonant absorption of radiation by nuclei or unpaired electrons in a magnetic field. From eqn 15.8b, the separation between the ms = − 1 –2 and ms = + 1 –2 levels of an electron spin in a magnetic field B0 is ∆E = Eα − Eβ = geµBB0 (15.12a) If the sample is exposed to radiation of frequency ν, the energy separations come into resonance with the radiation when the frequency satisfies the resonance condition (Fig. 15.2): hν = geµBB0 (15.12b) At resonance there is strong coupling between the electron spins and the radiation, and strong absorption occurs as the spins make the transition β → α. Electron paramagnetic resonance (EPR), or electron spin resonance (ESR), is the study of molecules and ions containing unpaired electrons by observing the magnetic fields at which they come into resonance with monochromatic radiation. Magnetic fields of about 0.3 T (the value used in most commercial EPR spectrometers) correspond to resonance with an electromagnetic field of frequency 10 GHz (1010 Hz) and wavelength 3 cm. Because 3 cm radiation falls in the microwave region of the electromagnetic spectrum, EPR is a microwave technique. e$ 2mp Synoptic table 15.2* Nuclear spin properties Natural Magnetogyric NMR frequency Nuclide abundance/% Spin I g-factor, gI ratio, g/(107 T−1 s−1 ) at 1 T, n/MHz 1 n 1 –2 −3.826 −18.32 29.165 1 H 99.98 1 –2 5.586 26.75 42.577 2 H 0.02 1 0.857 4.10 6.536 13 C 1.11 1 –2 1.405 6.73 10.705 14 N 99.64 1 0.404 1.93 3.076 * More values are given in the Data section. b a ms = ms = + Magnetic field off Magnetic field on ge B 0B -2 1 -2 1 m Fig. 15.2 Electron spin levels in a magnetic field. Note that the β state is lower in energy than the α state (because the magnetogyric ratio of an electron is negative). Resonance is achieved when the frequency of the incident radiation matches the frequency corresponding to the energy separation. 15.4 THE NMR SPECTROMETER 517 The energy separation between the mI = +1 –2 (↑ or α) and the mI = −1 –2 (↓ or β) states of spin-1 –2 nuclei, which are nuclei with I = 1 –2, is ∆E = Eβ − Eα = 1 –2γ $B0 − (− 1 –2γ $B0) = γ $B0 (15.13a) and resonant absorption occurs when the resonance condition (Fig. 15.3) hν = γ $B0 (15.13b) is fulfilled. Because γ $B0/h is the Larmor frequency of the nucleus, this resonance occurs when the frequency of the electromagnetic field matches the Larmor frequency (ν = νL). In its simplest form, nuclear magnetic resonance (NMR) is the study of the properties of molecules containing magnetic nuclei by applying a magnetic field and observing the frequency of the resonant electromagnetic field. Larmor frequencies of nuclei at the fields normally employed (about 12 T) typically lie in the radiofrequency region of the electromagnetic spectrum (close to 500 MHz), so NMR is a radiofrequency technique. For much of this chapter we consider spin-1 –2 nuclei, but NMR is applicable to nuclei with any non-zero spin. As well as protons, which are the most common nuclei studied by NMR, spin-1 –2 nuclei include 13 C, 19 F, and 31 P. Nuclear magnetic resonance Although the NMR technique is simple in concept, NMR spectra can be highly complex. However, they have proved invaluable in chemistry, for they reveal so much structural information. A magnetic nucleus is a very sensitive, non-invasive probe of the surrounding electronic structure. 15.4 The NMR spectrometer An NMR spectrometer consists of the appropriate sources of radiofrequency electromagnetic radiation and a magnet that can produce a uniform, intense field. In simple instruments, the magnetic field is provided by a permanent magnet. For serious work, a superconducting magnet capable of producing fields of the order of 10 T and more is used (Fig. 15.4). The sample is placed in the cylindrically wound magnet. In some cases the sample is rotated rapidly to average out magnetic inhomogeneities. However, sample spinning can lead to irreproducible results, and is often avoided. Although a superconducting magnet operates at the temperature of liquid helium (4 K), the sample itself is normally at room temperature. The intensity of an NMR transition depends on a number of factors. We show in the following Justification that Intensity ∝ (Nα − Nβ)B0 (15.14a) where Nα − Nβ ≈ (15.14b) with N the total number of spins (N = Nα + Nβ). It follows that decreasing the temperature increases the intensity by increasing the population difference. By combining these two equations we see that the intensity is proportional to B0 2 , so NMR transitions can be enhanced significantly by increasing the strength of the applied magnetic field. We shall also see (Section 15.6) that the use of high magnetic fields simplifies the Nγ $B0 2kT b a mI = mI = + Field off Field on hB0 -2 1 -2 1 g Fig. 15.3 The nuclear spin energy levels of a spin-1–2 nucleus with positive magnetogyric ratio (for example, 1 H or 13 C) in a magnetic field. Resonance occurs when the energy separation of the levels matches the energy of the photons in the electromagnetic field. Superconducting magnet Probe Preamplifier Receiver Detector Computer Transmitter Fig. 15.4 The layout of a typical NMR spectrometer. The link from the transmitter to the detector indicates that the high frequency of the transmitter is subtracted from the high frequency received signal to give a low frequency signal for processing. 518 15 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 3: MAGNETIC RESONANCE appearance of spectra and so allows them to be interpreted more readily. We also conclude that absorptions of nuclei with large magnetogyric ratios (1 H, for instance) are more intense than those with small magnetogyric ratios (13 C, for instance) Justification 15.1 Intensities in NMR spectra From the general considerations of transition intensities in Section 13.2, we know that the rate of absorption of electromagnetic radiation is proportional to the population of the lower energy state (Nα in the case of a proton NMR transition) and the rate of stimulated emission is proportional to the population of the upper state (Nβ). At the low frequencies typical of magnetic resonance, we can neglect spontaneous emission as it is very slow. Therefore, the net rate of absorption is proportional to the difference in populations, and we can write Rate of absorption ∝ Nα − Nβ The intensity of absorption, the rate at which energy is absorbed, is proportional to the product of the rate of absorption (the rate at which photons are absorbed) and the energy of each photon, and the latter is proportional to the frequency ν of the incident radiation (through E = hν). At resonance, this frequency is proportional to the applied magnetic field (through ν = νL = γB0/2π), so we can write Intensity of absorption ∝ (Nα − Nβ)B0 as in eqn 15.14a. To write an expression for the population difference, we use the Boltzmann distribution (Molecular interpretation 3.1) to write the ratio of populations as = e−∆E/kT ≈ 1 − = 1 − where ∆E = Eβ − Eα. The expansion of the exponential term is appropriate for ∆E< = C <=C C in ArX-X R N- ºC R OOH-C R HO-C R O2C= R R= =C R3C+ - º -C C (a) H resonances1 (b) C resonances13 Fig. 15.5 The range of typical chemical shifts for (a) 1 H resonances and (b) 13 C resonances. very different ranges of chemical shifts. The ranges exhibit the variety of electronic environments of the nuclei in molecules: the heavier the element, the greater the number of electrons around the nucleus and hence the greater the range of shieldings. By convention, NMR spectra are plotted with δ increasing from right to left. Consequently, in a given applied magnetic field the Larmor frequency also increases from right to left. In the original continuous wave (CW) spectrometers, in which the radiofrequency was held constant and the magnetic field varied (a ‘field sweep experiment’), the spectrum was displayed with the applied magnetic field increasing from left to right: a nucleus with a small chemical shift experiences a relatively low local magnetic field, so it needs a higher applied magnetic field to bring it into resonance with the radiofrequency field. Consequently, the right-hand (low chemical shift) end of the spectrum became known as the ‘high field end’ of the spectrum. (b) Resonance of different groups of nuclei The existence of a chemical shift explains the general features of the spectrum of ethanol shown in Fig.15.6. The CH3 protons form one group of nuclei with δ ≈ 1. The two CH2 protons are in a different part of the molecule, experience a different local magnetic field, and resonate at δ ≈ 3. Finally, the OH proton is in another environment, and has a chemical shift of δ ≈ 4. The increasing value of δ (that is, the decrease in shielding) is consistent with the electron-withdrawing power of the O atom: it reduces the electron density of the OH proton most, and that proton is strongly deshielded. It reduces the electron density of the distant methyl protons least, and those nuclei are least deshielded. d CH CH O3 2 H CH C OH3 2H C CH OHH3 2 3.64.0 1.2 Fig. 15.6 The 1 H-NMR spectrum of ethanol. The bold letters denote the protons giving rise to the resonance peak, and the step-like curve is the integrated signal. 15.5 THE CHEMICAL SHIFT 521 The relative intensities of the signals (the areas under the absorption lines) can be used to help distinguish which group of lines corresponds to which chemical group. The determination of the area under an absorption line is referred to as the integration of the signal (just as any area under a curve may be determined by mathematical integration). Spectrometers can integrate the absorption automatically (as indicated in Fig. 15.6). In ethanol the group intensities are in the ratio 3:2:1 because there are three CH3 protons, two CH2 protons, and one OH proton in each molecule. Counting the number of magnetic nuclei as well as noting their chemical shifts helps to identify a compound present in a sample. (c) The origin of shielding constants The calculation of shielding constants is difficult, even for small molecules, for it requires detailed information about the distribution of electron density in the ground and excited states and the excitation energies of the molecule. Nevertheless, considerable success has been achieved with the calculation for diatomic molecules and small molecules such as H2O and CH4 and even large molecules, such as proteins, are within the scope of some types of calculation. Nevertheless, it is easier to understand the different contributions to chemical shifts by studying the large body of empirical information now available for large molecules. The empirical approach supposes that the observed shielding constant is the sum of three contributions: σ = σ(local) + σ(neighbour) + σ(solvent) (15.20) The local contribution, σ(local), is essentially the contribution of the electrons of the atom that contains the nucleus in question. The neighbouring group contribution, σ(neighbour), is the contribution from the groups of atoms that form the rest of the molecule. The solvent contribution, σ(solvent), is the contribution from the solvent molecules. (d) The local contribution It is convenient to regard the local contribution to the shielding constant as the sum of a diamagnetic contribution, σd, and a paramagnetic contribution, σp: σ(local) = σd + σp (15.21) A diamagnetic contribution to σ(local) opposes the applied magnetic field and shields the nucleus in question. A paramagnetic contribution to σ(local) reinforces the applied magnetic field and deshields the nucleus in question. Therefore, σd > 0 and σp < 0. The total local contribution is positive if the diamagnetic contribution dominates, and is negative if the paramagnetic contribution dominates. The diamagnetic contribution arises from the ability of the applied field to generate a circulation of charge in the ground-state electron distribution of the atom. The circulation generates a magnetic field that opposes the applied field and hence shields the nucleus. The magnitude of σd depends on the electron density close to the nucleus and can be calculated from the Lamb formula (see Further reading for a derivation): σd = (15.22) where µ0 is the vacuum permeability (a fundamental constant, see inside the front cover) and r is the electron–nucleus distance. 1 r e2 µ0 12πme 522 15 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 3: MAGNETIC RESONANCE 4 3 2 1 2 2.5 3 3.5 4 ChemicalshiftrelativetoCH,4 Electronegativity of halogen FClBrI CH C X3 2H C CH X3 2H d Fig. 15.7 The variation of chemical shielding with electronegativity. The shifts for the methylene protons agree with the trend expected with increasing electronegativity. However, to emphasize that chemical shifts are subtle phenomena, notice that the trend for the methyl protons is opposite to that expected. For these protons another contribution (the magnetic anisotropy of C-H and C-X bonds) is dominant. Illustration 15.2 Calculating the diamagnetic contribution to the chemical shift of a proton To calculate σd for the proton in a free H atom, we need to calculate the expectation value of 1/r for a hydrogen 1s orbital. Wavefunctions are given in Table 10.1, and a useful integral is given in Example 8.7. Because dτ = r2 dr sin θ dθdφ, we can write = Ύ dτ = Ύ 2π 0 dφΎ π 0 sinθdθ Ύ ∞ 0 re−2r/a0 dr = Ύ ∞ 0 re−2r/a0 dr = Therefore, σd = With the values of the fundamental constants inside the front cover, this expression evaluates to 1.78 × 10−5 . The diamagnetic contribution is the only contribution in closed-shell free atoms. It is also the only contribution to the local shielding for electron distributions that have spherical or cylindrical symmetry. Thus, it is the only contribution to the local shielding from inner cores of atoms, for cores remain spherical even though the atom may be a component of a molecule and its valence electron distribution highly distorted. The diamagnetic contribution is broadly proportional to the electron density of the atom containing the nucleus of interest. It follows that the shielding is decreased if the electron density on the atom is reduced by the influence of an electronegative atom nearby. That reduction in shielding translates into an increase in deshielding, and hence to an increase in the chemical shift δ as the electronegativity of a neighbouring atom increases (Fig. 15.7). That is, as the electronegativity increases, δ decreases. The local paramagnetic contribution, σp, arises from the ability of the applied field to force electrons to circulate through the molecule by making use of orbitals that are unoccupied in the ground state. It is zero in free atoms and around the axes of linear molecules (such as ethyne, HC.CH) where the electrons can circulate freely and a field applied along the internuclear axis is unable to force them into other orbitals. We can expect large paramagnetic contributions from small atoms in molecules with lowlying excited states. In fact, the paramagnetic contribution is the dominant local contribution for atoms other than hydrogen. (e) Neighbouring group contributions The neighbouring group contribution arises from the currents induced in nearby groups of atoms. Consider the influence of the neighbouring group X on the proton H in a molecule such as H-X. The applied field generates currents in the electron distribution of X and gives rise to an induced magnetic moment proportional to the applied field; the constant of proportionality is the magnetic susceptibility, χ (chi), of the group X. The proton H is affected by this induced magnetic moment in two ways. First, the strength of the additional magnetic field the proton experiences is inversely proportional to the cube of the distance r between H and X. Second, the field at H depends on the anisotropy of the magnetic susceptibility of X, the variation of χ with the angle that X makes to the applied field. We assume that the magnetic susceptibility of X has two components, χ|| and χ⊥, which are parallel and perpendicular to the axis of symmetry of X, respectively. The axis of symmetry of X makes an angle θ to the e2 µ0 12πmea0 1 a0 4 a3 0 1 πa3 0 ψ*ψ r 1 r 15.5 THE CHEMICAL SHIFT 523 rq || | c c 1 B 2 B 3 -2 0 1 13cos2 0 p p q –2 1 qFig. 15.8 The variation of the function 1 – 3 cos2 θ with the angle θ. vector connecting X to H (1, where X is represented by the ellipse and H is represented by the circle). To examine the effect of anisotropy of the magnetic susceptibility of X on the shielding constant, consider the case θ = 0 for a molecule H-X that is free to tumble (2 and 3). Some of the time the H-X axis will be perpendicular to the applied field and then only χ⊥ will contribute to the induced magnetic moment that shields X from the applied field. The result is deshielding of the proton H, or σ(neighbour) < 0 (2). When the applied field is parallel to the H-X axis, only χ|| contributes to the induced magnetic moment at X. The result is shielding of the proton H (3). We conclude that, as the molecule tumbles and the H-X axis takes all possible angles with respect to the applied field, the effects of anisotropic magnetic susceptibility do not average to zero because χ|| ≠ χ⊥. Self-test 15.1 For a tumbling H-X molecule, show that when θ = 90°: (a) contributions from the χ⊥ component lead to shielding of H, or σ(neighbour) > 0, and (b) contributions from the χ|| component lead to deshielding of H, or σ(neighbour) < 0. Comparison between the θ = 0 and θ = 90° cases shows that the patterns of shielding and deshielding by neighbouring groups depend not only on differences between χ|| and χ⊥, but also the angle θ. [Draw diagrams similar to 2 and 3 where the χ⊥ component is parallel to the H-X axis and then analyse the problem as above.] To a good approximation, the shielding constant σ(neighbour) depends on the distance r, the difference χ|| − χ⊥, as (see Further reading for a derivation) σ(neighbour) ∝ (χ|| − χ⊥) (15.23) where χ|| and χ⊥ are both negative for a diamagnetic group X. Equation 15.23 shows that the neighbouring group contribution may be positive or negative according to the relative magnitudes of the two magnetic susceptibilities and the relative orientation of the nucleus with respect to X. The latter effect is easy to anticipate: if 54.7° < θ < 125.3°, then 1 − 3 cos2 θ is positive, but it is negative otherwise (Fig. 15.8). A special case of a neighbouring group effect is found in aromatic compounds. The strong anisotropy of the magnetic susceptibility of the benzene ring is ascribed to the D F 1 − 3cos2 θ r3 A C 524 15 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 3: MAGNETIC RESONANCE ability of the field to induce a ring current, a circulation of electrons around the ring, when it is applied perpendicular to the molecular plane. Protons in the plane are deshielded (Fig. 15.9), but any that happen to lie above or below the plane (as members of substituents of the ring) are shielded. (f) The solvent contribution A solvent can influence the local magnetic field experienced by a nucleus in a variety of ways. Some of these effects arise from specific interactions between the solute and the solvent (such as hydrogen-bond formation and other forms of Lewis acid–base complex formation). The anisotropy of the magnetic susceptibility of the solvent molecules, especially if they are aromatic, can also be the source of a local magnetic field. Moreover, if there are steric interactions that result in a loose but specific interaction between a solute molecule and a solvent molecule, then protons in the solute molecule may experience shielding or deshielding effects according to their location relative to the solvent molecule (Fig. 15.10). We shall see that the NMR spectra of species that contain protons with widely different chemical shifts are easier to interpret than those in which the shifts are similar, so the appropriate choice of solvent may help to simplify the appearance and interpretation of a spectrum. 15.6 The fine structure The splitting of resonances into individual lines in Fig. 15.6 is called the fine structure of the spectrum. It arises because each magnetic nucleus may contribute to the local field experienced by the other nuclei and so modify their resonance frequencies. The strength of the interaction is expressed in terms of the scalarcouplingconstant, J, and reported in hertz (Hz). The scalar coupling constant is so called because the energy of interaction it describes is proportional to the scalar product of the two interacting spins: E ∝ I1·I2. The constant of proportionality in this expression is hJ/$2 , because each angular momentum is proportional to $. Spin coupling constants are independent of the strength of the applied field because they do not depend on the latter for their ability to generate local fields. If the resonance line of a particular nucleus is split by a certain amount by a second nucleus, then the resonance line of the second nucleus is split by the first to the same extent. (a) The energy levels of coupled systems It will be useful for later discussions to consider an NMR spectrum in terms of the energy levels of the nuclei and the transitions between them. In NMR, letters far apart in the alphabet (typically A and X) are used to indicate nuclei with very different chemical shifts; letters close together (such as A and B) are used for nuclei with similar chemical shifts. We shall consider first an AX system, a molecule that contains two spin-1 –2 nuclei A and X with very different chemical shifts in the sense that the difference in chemical shift corresponds to a frequency that is large compared to their spin–spin coupling. The energy level diagram for a single spin-1 –2 nucleus and its single transition were shown in Fig. 15.3, and nothing more needs to be said. For a spin-1 –2 AX system there are four spin states: αAαX αAβX βAαX βAβX The energy depends on the orientation of the spins in the external magnetic field, and if spin–spin coupling is neglected E = −γ $(1 − σA)BmA − γ $(1 − σX)BmX = −hνAmA − hνXmX (15.24) B Ring current Magnetic field Fig. 15.9 The shielding and deshielding effects of the ring current induced in the benzene ring by the applied field. Protons attached to the ring are deshielded but a proton attached to a substituent that projects above the ring is shielded. H Fig. 15.10 An aromatic solvent (benzene here) can give rise to local currents that shield or deshield a proton in a solvent molecule. In this relative orientation of the solvent and solute, the proton on the solute molecule is shielded. 15.6 THE FINE STRUCTURE 525 where νA and νX are the Larmor frequencies of A and X and mA and mX are their quantum numbers. This expression gives the four lines on the left of Fig. 15.11. The spin–spin coupling depends on the relative orientation of the two nuclear spins, so it is proportional to the product mAmX. Therefore, the energy including spin–spin coupling is E = −hνAmA − hνXmX + hJmAmX (15.25) If J > 0, a lower energy is obtained when mAmX < 0, which is the case if one spin is α and the other is β. A higher energy is obtained if both spins are α or both spins are β. The opposite is true if J < 0. The resulting energy level diagram (for J > 0) is shown on the right of Fig. 15.11. We see that the αα and ββ states are both raised by 1 –4hJ and that the αβ and βα states are both lowered by 1 –4hJ. When a transition of nucleus A occurs, nucleus X remains unchanged. Therefore, the A resonance is a transition for which ∆mA = +1 and ∆mX = 0. There are two such transitions, one in which βA ← αA occurs when the X nucleus is αX, and the other in which βA ← αA occurs when the X nucleus is βX. They are shown in Fig. 15.11 and in a slightly different form in Fig. 15.12. The energies of the transitions are ∆E = hνA ± 1 –2hJ (15.26a) Therefore, the A resonance consists of a doublet of separation J centred on the chemical shift of A (Fig. 15.13). Similar remarks apply to the X resonance, which consists of two transitions according to whether the A nucleus is α or β (as shown in Fig. 15.12). The transition energies are ∆E = hνX ± 1 –2hJ (15.26b) It follows that the X resonance also consists of two lines of separation J, but they are centred on the chemical shift of X (as shown in Fig. 15.13). Energy hJ hJ hJ hJ No spin spin coupling - With spin spin coupling h hL L(A) (X)+-2 1 -2 1 n n h hL L(A) (X)--2 1 -2 1 n n h hL L(A) (X)+-2 1 -2 1 n n h hL L(A) (X)--2 1 -2 1 n n - - 1 1 -4 1 -4 1 -4 1 -4 1 A Xa a A Xa b A Xb a A Xb b XX®ba AA®ba XX®ba AA®ba A Xb b A Xb a A Xa b A Xa a Fig. 15.12 An alternative depiction of the energy levels and transitions shown in Fig. 15.11. Once again, we have exaggerated the effect of spin–spin coupling. J J Aresonance Xresonance A X d d Fig. 15.13 The effect of spin–spin coupling on an AX spectrum. Each resonance is split into two lines separated by J. The pairs of resonances are centred on the chemical shifts of the protons in the absence of spin–spin coupling. Fig. 15.11 The energy levels of an AX system. The four levels on the left are those of the two spins in the absence of spin–spin coupling. The four levels on the right show how a positive spin–spin coupling constant affects the energies. The transitions shown are for β ← α of A or X, the other nucleus (X or A, respectively) remaining unchanged. We have exaggerated the effect for clarity; in practice, the splitting caused by spin–spin coupling is much smaller than that caused by the applied field. 526 15 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 3: MAGNETIC RESONANCE (b) Patterns of coupling We have seen that in an AX system, spin–spin coupling will result in four lines in the NMR spectrum. Instead of a single line from A, we get a doublet of lines separated by J and centred on the chemical shift characteristic of A. The same splitting occurs in the X resonance: instead of a single line, the resonance is a doublet with splitting J (the same value as for the splitting of A) centred on the chemical shift characteristic of X. These features are summarized in Fig. 15.13. A subtle point is that the X resonance in an AXn species (such as an AX2 or AX3 species) is also a doublet with splitting J. As we shall explain below, a group of equivalent nuclei resonates like a single nucleus. The only difference for the X resonance of an AXn species is that the intensity is n times as great as that of an AX species (Fig. 15.14). The A resonance in an AXn species, though, is quite different from the A resonance in an AX species. For example, consider an AX2 species with two equivalent X nuclei. The resonance of A is split into a doublet of separation J by one X, and each line of that doublet is split again by the same amount by the second X (Fig. 15.15). This splitting results in three lines in the intensity ratio 1:2:1 (because the central frequency can be obtained in two ways). The A resonance of an AnX2 species would also be a 1:2:1 triplet of splitting J, the only difference being that the intensity of the A resonance would be n times as great as that of AX2. Three equivalent X nuclei (an AX3 species) split the resonance of A into four lines of intensity ratio 1:3:3:1 and separation J (Fig. 15.16). The X resonance, though, is still a doublet of separation J. In general, n equivalent spin-1 –2 nuclei split the resonance of a nearby spin or group of equivalent spins into n + 1 lines with an intensity distribution given by ‘Pascal’s triangle’ in which each entry is the sum of the two entries immediately above (4). The easiest way of constructing the pattern of fine structure is to draw a diagram in which successive rows show the splitting of a subsequent proton. The procedure is illustrated in Fig. 15.17 and was used in Figs. 15.15 and 15.16. It is easily extended to molecules containing nuclei with I > 1 –2 (Fig. 15.18). J X resonance in AX X resonance in AX2 Xd Ad Fig. 15.14 The X resonance of an AX2 species is also a doublet, because the two equivalent X nuclei behave like a single nucleus; however, the overall absorption is twice as intense as that of an AX species. Fig. 15.15 The origin of the 1:2:1 triplet in the A resonance of an AX2 species. The resonance of A is split into two by coupling with one X nucleus (as shown in the inset), and then each of those two lines is split into two by coupling to the second X nucleus. Because each X nucleus causes the same splitting, the two central transitions are coincident and give rise to an absorption line of double the intensity of the outer lines. Ad Fig. 15.16 The origin of the 1:3:3:1 quartet in the A resonance of an AX3 species. The third X nucleus splits each of the lines shown in Fig. 15.15 for an AX2 species into a doublet, and the intensity distribution reflects the number of transitions that have the same energy. 1 1 1 1 2 1 1 3 3 1 1 4 6 4 1 1 5 10 10 5 1 4 15.6 THE FINE STRUCTURE 527 0 1 2 3 4 1 4 6 4 1 1 2 1 2 3 2 1 0 Fig. 15.17 The intensity distribution of the A resonance of an AXn resonance can be constructed by considering the splitting caused by 1, 2, . . . n protons, as in Figs. 15.15 and 15.16. The resulting intensity distribution has a binomial distribution and is given by the integers in the corresponding row of Pascal’s triangle. Note that, although the lines have been drawn side-by-side for clarity, the members of each group are coincident. Four protons, in AX4, split the A resonance into a 1:4:6:4:1 quintet. Fig. 15.18 The intensity distribution arising from spin–spin interaction with nuclei with I = 1 can be constructed similarly, but each successive nucleus splits the lines into three equal intensity components. Two equivalent spin-1 nuclei give rise to a 1:2:3:2:1 quintet. Example 15.1 Accounting for the fine structure in a spectrum Account for the fine structure in the NMR spectrum of the C-H protons of ethanol. Method Consider how each group of equivalent protons (for instance, three methyl protons) split the resonances of the other groups of protons. There is no splitting within groups of equivalent protons. Each splitting pattern can be decided by referring to Pascal’s triangle. Answer The three protons of the CH3 group split the resonance of the CH2 protons into a 1:3:3:1 quartet with a splitting J. Likewise, the two protons of the CH2 group split the resonance of the CH3 protons into a 1:2:1 triplet with the same splitting J. The CH2 and CH3 protons all interact with the OH proton, but these couplings do not cause any splitting because the OH protons migrate rapidly from molecule to molecule and their effect averages to zero. Self-test 15.2 What fine-structure can be expected for the protons in 14 NH4 + ? The spin quantum number of nitrogen is 1. [1:1:1 triplet from N] (c) The magnitudes of coupling constants The scalar coupling constant of two nuclei separated by N bonds is denoted N J, with subscripts for the types of nuclei involved. Thus, 1 JCH is the coupling constant for a proton joined directly to a 13 C atom, and 2 JCH is the coupling constant when the same two nuclei are separated by two bonds (as in 13 C-C-H). A typical value of 1 JCH is in the range 120 to 250 Hz; 2 JCH is between −10 and +20 Hz. Both 3 J and 4 J can give detectable effects in a spectrum, but couplings over larger numbers of bonds can generally 528 15 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 3: MAGNETIC RESONANCE be ignored. One of the longest range couplings that has been detected is 9 JHH = 0.4 Hz between the CH3 and CH2 protons in CH3C.CC.CC.CCH2OH. The sign of JXY indicates whether the energy of two spins is lower when they are parallel (J < 0) or when they are antiparallel (J > 0). It is found that 1 JCH is often positive, 2 JHH is often negative, 3 JHH is often positive, and so on. An additional point is that J varies with the angle between the bonds (Fig. 15.19). Thus, a 3 JHH coupling constant is often found to depend on the dihedral angle φ (5) according to the Karplus equation: J = A + B cos φ + C cos 2φ (15.27) with A, B, and C empirical constants with values close to +7 Hz, −1 Hz, and +5 Hz, respectively, for an HCCH fragment. It follows that the measurement of 3 JHH in a series of related compounds can be used to determine their conformations. The coupling constant 1 JCH also depends on the hybridization of the C atom, as the following values indicate: sp sp2 sp3 1 JCH/Hz: 250 160 125 (d) The origin of spin–spin coupling Spin–spin coupling is a very subtle phenomenon, and it is better to treat J as an empirical parameter than to use calculated values. However, we can get some insight into its origins, if not its precise magnitude—or always reliably its sign—by considering the magnetic interactions within molecules. A nucleus with spin projection mI gives rise to a magnetic field with z-component Bnuc at a distance R, where, to a good approximation, Bnuc = − (1 − 3cos2 θ)mI (15.28) The angle θ is defined in (6). The magnitude of this field is about 0.1 mT when R = 0.3 nm, corresponding to a splitting of resonance signal of about 104 Hz, and is of the order of magnitude of the splitting observed in solid samples (see Section 15.3a). In a liquid, the angle θ sweeps over all values as the molecule tumbles, and 1–3 cos2 θ averages to zero. Hence the direct dipolar interaction between spins cannot account for the fine structure of the spectra of rapidly tumbling molecules. The direct interaction does make an important contribution to the spectra of solid samples and is a very useful indirect source of structure information through its involvement in spin relaxation (Section 15.11). Spin–spin coupling in molecules in solution can be explained in terms of the polarization mechanism, in which the interaction is transmitted through the bonds. The simplest case to consider is that of 1 JXY where X and Y are spin-1 –2 nuclei joined by an electron-pair bond (Fig. 15.20). The coupling mechanism depends on the fact that in some atoms it is favourable for the nucleus and a nearby electron spin to be parallel (both α or both β), but in others it is favourable for them to be antiparallel (one α and the other β). The electron–nucleus coupling is magnetic in origin, and may be either a dipolar interaction between the magnetic moments of the electron and nuclear spins or a Fermi contact interaction. A pictorial description of the Fermi contact interaction is as follows. First, we regard the magnetic moment of the nucleus as arising from the circulation of a current in a tiny loop with a radius similar to that of the nucleus (Fig. 15.21). Far from the nucleus the field generated by this loop is indistinguishable from the field generated by a point magnetic dipole. Close to the loop, however, the field differs from that of a point dipole. The magnetic interaction between this non-dipolar field and the electron’s magnetic moment is the contact γ $µ0 4πR3 14 12 10 8 6 4 2 0 0 90° 180° Angle, Spin–spincoupling,/HzJ HCCH HNCH f Fig. 15.19 The variation of the spin–spin coupling constant with angle predicted by the Karplus equation for an HCCH group and an HNCH group. Exploration Draw a family of curves showing the variation of 3 JHH with φ for which A = +7.0 Hz, B = −1.0 Hz, and C varies slightly from a typical value of +5.0 Hz. What is the effect of changing the value of the parameter C on the shape of the curve? In a similar fashion, explore the effect of the values of A and B on the shape of the curve. f H H 5 q R 6 Comment 15.4 The average (or mean value) of a function f(x) over the range x = a to x = b is Ú b a f(x)dx/(b − a). The volume element in polar coordinates is proportional to sin q dq, and q ranges from 0 to p. Therefore the average value of (1 – 3 cos2 q) is Ú p 0 (1 – 3 cos2 q) sin q dq/p = 0. 15.6 THE FINE STRUCTURE 529 interaction. The lines of force depicted in Fig. 15.21 correspond to those for a proton with α spin. The lower energy state of an electron spin in such a field is the β state. In conclusion, the contact interaction depends on the very close approach of an electron to the nucleus and hence can occur only if the electron occupies an s orbital (which is the reason why 1 JCH depends on the hybridization ratio). We shall suppose that it is energetically favourable for an electron spin and a nuclear spin to be antiparallel (as is the case for a proton and an electron in a hydrogen atom). If the X nucleus is α, a β electron of the bonding pair will tend to be found nearby (because that is energetically favourable for it). The second electron in the bond, which must have α spin if the other is β, will be found mainly at the far end of the bond (because electrons tend to stay apart to reduce their mutual repulsion). Because it is energetically favourable for the spin of Y to be antiparallel to an electron spin, a Y nucleus with β spin has a lower energy, and hence a lower Larmor frequency, than a Y nucleus with α spin. The opposite is true when X is β, for now the α spin of Y has the lower energy. In other words, the antiparallel arrangement of nuclear spins lies lower in energy than the parallel arrangement as a result of their magnetic coupling with the bond electrons. That is, 1 JHH is positive. To account for the value of 2 JXY, as in H-C-H, we need a mechanism that can transmit the spin alignments through the central C atom (which may be 12 C, with no nuclear spin of its own). In this case (Fig. 15.22), an X nucleus with α spin polarizes the electrons in its bond, and the α electron is likely to be found closer to the C nucleus. The more favourable arrangement of two electrons on the same atom is with their spins parallel (Hund’s rule, Section 10.4d), so the more favourable arrangement is for the α electron of the neighbouring bond to be close to the C nucleus. Consequently, the β electron of that bond is more likely to be found close to the Y nucleus, and therefore that nucleus will have a lower energy if it is α. Hence, according to this mechanism, the lower Larmor frequency of Y will be obtained if its spin is parallel to that of X. That is, 2 JHH is negative. X Y X Y Fermi FermiPauli Fig. 15.20 The polarization mechanism for spin–spin coupling (1 JHH). The two arrangements have slightly different energies. In this case, J is positive, corresponding to a lower energy when the nuclear spins are antiparallel. Fig. 15.21 The origin of the Fermi contact interaction. From far away, the magnetic field pattern arising from a ring of current (representing the rotating charge of the nucleus, the pale green sphere) is that of a point dipole. However, if an electron can sample the field close to the region indicated by the sphere, the field distribution differs significantly from that of a point dipole. For example, if the electron can penetrate the sphere, then the spherical average of the field it experiences is not zero. X Fermi Fermi Pauli Pauli Hund Y C Fig. 15.22 The polarization mechanism for 2 JHH spin–spin coupling. The spin information is transmitted from one bond to the next by a version of the mechanism that accounts for the lower energy of electrons with parallel spins in different atomic orbitals (Hund’s rule of maximum multiplicity). In this case, J < 0, corresponding to a lower energy when the nuclear spins are parallel. 530 15 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 3: MAGNETIC RESONANCE The coupling of nuclear spin to electron spin by the Fermi contact interaction is most important for proton spins, but it is not necessarily the most important mechanism for other nuclei. These nuclei may also interact by a dipolar mechanism with the electron magnetic moments and with their orbital motion, and there is no simple way of specifying whether J will be positive or negative. (e) Equivalent nuclei A group of nuclei are chemically equivalent if they are related by a symmetry operation of the molecule and have the same chemical shifts. Chemically equivalent nuclei are nuclei that would be regarded as ‘equivalent’ according to ordinary chemical criteria. Nuclei are magnetically equivalent if, as well as being chemically equivalent, they also have identical spin–spin interactions with any other magnetic nuclei in the molecule. The difference between chemical and magnetic equivalence is illustrated by CH2F2 and H2C=CF2. In each of these molecules the protons are chemically equivalent: they are related by symmetry and undergo the same chemical reactions. However, although the protons in CH2F2 are magnetically equivalent, those in CH2=CF2 are not. One proton in the latter has a cis spin-coupling interaction with a given F nucleus whereas the other proton has a trans interaction with it. In constrast, in CH2F2 both protons are connected to a given F nucleus by identical bonds, so there is no distinction between them. Strictly speaking, the CH3 protons in ethanol (and other compounds) are magnetically inequivalent on account of their different interactions with the CH2 protons in the next group. However, they are in practice made magnetically equivalent by the rapid rotation of the CH3 group, which averages out any differences. Magnetically inequivalent species can give very complicated spectra (for instance, the proton and 19 F spectra of H2C=CF2 each consist of 12 lines), and we shall not consider them further. An important feature of chemically equivalent magnetic nuclei is that, although they do couple together, the coupling has no effect on the appearance of the spectrum. The reason for the invisibility of the coupling is set out in the following Justification, but qualitatively it is that all allowed nuclear spin transitions are collective reorientations of groups of equivalent nuclear spins that do not change the relative orientations of the spins within the group (Fig. 15.23). Then, because the relative orientations of nuclear spins are not changed in any transition, the magnitude of the coupling between them is undetectable. Hence, an isolated CH3 group gives a single, unsplit line because all the allowed transitions of the group of three protons occur without change of their relative orientations. f f f Two intermediate orientations a a a a a a b b b b b b (a) (b) Fig. 15.23 (a) A group of two equivalent nuclei realigns as a group, without change of angle between the spins, when a resonant absorption occurs. Hence it behaves like a single nucleus and the spin–spin coupling between the individual spins of the group is undetectable. (b) Three equivalent nuclei also realign as a group without change of their relative orientations. 15.6 THE FINE STRUCTURE 531 Justification 15.2 The energy levels of an A2 system Consider an A2 system of two chemically equivalent spin-1 –2 nuclei. First, consider the energy levels in the absence of spin–spin coupling. There are four spin states that (just as for two electrons) can be classified according to their total spin I (the analogue of S for two electrons) and their total projection MI on the z-axis. The states are analogous to those we developed for two electrons in singlet and triplet states: Spins parallel, I = 1: MI = +1 αα MI = 0 (1/21/2 ){αβ + βα} MI = −1 ββ Spins paired, I = 0: MI = 0 (1/21/2 ){αβ − βα} The effect of a magnetic field on these four states is shown in Fig. 15.24: the energies of the two states with MI = 0 are unchanged by the field because they are composed of equal proportions of α and β spins. As remarked in Section 15.6a, the spin–spin coupling energy is proportional to the scalar product of the vectors representing the spins, E = (hJ/$2 )I1·I2. The scalar product can be expressed in terms of the total nuclear spin by noting that I2 = (I1 + I2)·(I1 + I2) = I1 2 + I2 2 + 2I1·I2 rearranging this expression to I1·I2 = 1 –2{I2 − I1 2 − I2 2 } and replacing the magnitudes by their quantum mechanical values: I1·I2 = 1 –2{I(I + 1) − I1(I1 + 1) − I2(I2 + 1)}$2 Then, because I1 = I2 = 1 –2, it follows that E = 1 –2hJ{I(I + 1) − 3 –2} For parallel spins, I = 1 and E = + 1 –4hJ; for antiparallel spins I = 0 and E = − 3 –4hJ, as in Fig. 15.24. We see that three of the states move in energy in one direction and the fourth (the one with antiparallel spins) moves three times as much in the opposite direction. The resulting energy levels are shown on the right in Fig. 15.24. The NMR spectrum of the A2 species arises from transitions between the levels. However, the radiofrequency field affects the two equivalent protons equally, so it cannot change the orientation of one proton relative to the other; therefore, the transitions take place within the set of states that correspond to parallel spin (those labelled I = 1), and no spin-parallel state can change to a spin-antiparallel state (the state with I = 0). Put another way, the allowed transitions are subject to the selection rule ∆I = 0. This selection rule is in addition to the rule ∆MI = ±1 that arises from the conservation of angular momentum and the unit spin of the photon. The allowed transitions are shown in Fig. 15.24: we see that there are only two transitions, and that they occur at the same resonance frequency that the nuclei would have in the absence of spin–spin coupling. Hence, the spin–spin coupling interaction does not affect the appearance of the spectrum. (f) Strongly coupled nuclei NMR spectra are usually much more complex than the foregoing simple analysis suggests. We have described the extreme case in which the differences in chemical shifts Comment 15.5 As in Section 10.7, the states we have selected in Justification 15.2 are those with a definite resultant, and hence a well defined value of I. The + sign in ab + ba signifies an in-phase alignment of spins and I = 1; the − sign in ab − ba signifies an alignment out of phase by p, and hence I = 0. See Fig. 10.24. bb ab ba ab ba aa I M 1, 1 = = +I I M 1, 0 = =I I M 0, 0 = =I I M = 1, = –1I + J + J + J - J No spin spin coupling - With spin spin coupling - + - –4 1 –4 1 –4 3 –4 1 Fig. 15.24 The energy levels of an A2 system in the absence of spin–spin coupling are shown on the left. When spin–spin coupling is taken into account, the energy levels on the right are obtained. Note that the three states with total nuclear spin I = 1 correspond to parallel spins and give rise to the same increase in energy (J is positive); the one state with I = 0 (antiparallel nuclear spins) has a lower energy in the presence of spin–spin coupling. The only allowed transitions are those that preserve the angle between the spins, and so take place between the three states with I = 1. They occur at the same resonance frequency as they would have in the absence of spin–spin coupling. 532 15 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 3: MAGNETIC RESONANCE ° <>D J n d n d n d n d Fig. 15.25 The NMR spectra of an A2 system (top) and an AX system (bottom) are simple ‘first-order’ spectra. At intermediate relative values of the chemical shift difference and the spin–spin coupling, complex ‘strongly coupled’ spectra are obtained. Note how the inner two lines of the bottom spectrum move together, grow in intensity, and form the single central line of the top spectrum. The two outer lines diminish in intensity and are absent in the top spectrum. C N OH Fig. 15.26 When a molecule changes from one conformation to another, the positions of its protons are interchanged and jump between magnetically distinct environments. are much greater than the spin–spin coupling constants. In such cases it is simple to identify groups of magnetically equivalent nuclei and to think of the groups of nuclear spins as reorientating relative to each other. The spectra that result are called firstorder spectra. Transitionscannotbeallocatedtodefinitegroupswhenthedifferencesintheirchemical shifts are comparable to their spin–spin coupling interactions. The complicated spectra that are then obtained are called strongly coupled spectra (or ‘second-order spectra’) and are much more difficult to analyse (Fig. 15.25). Because the difference in resonance frequencies increases with field, but spin–spin coupling constants are independent of it, a second-order spectrum may become simpler (and first-order) at high fields because individual groups of nuclei become identifiable again. A clue to the type of analysis that is appropriate is given by the notation for the types of spins involved. Thus, an AX spin system (which consists of two nuclei with a large chemical shift difference) has a first-order spectrum. An AB system, on the other hand (with two nuclei of similar chemical shifts), gives a spectrum typical of a strongly coupled system. An AX system may have widely different Larmor frequencies because A and X are nuclei of different elements (such as 13 C and 1 H), in which case they form a heteronuclear spin system. AX may also denote a homonuclear spin system in which the nuclei are of the same element but in markedly different environments. 15.7 Conformational conversion and exchange processes The appearance of an NMR spectrum is changed if magnetic nuclei can jump rapidly between different environments. Consider a molecule, such as N,N-dimethylformamide, that can jump between conformations; in its case, the methyl shifts depend on whether they are cis or trans to the carbonyl group (Fig. 15.26). When the jumping rate is low, the spectrum shows two sets of lines, one each from molecules in each conformation. When the interconversion is fast, the spectrum shows a single line at the mean of the two chemical shifts. At intermediate inversion rates, the line is very broad. This maximum broadening occurs when the lifetime, τ, of a conformation gives rise to a linewidth that is comparable to the difference of resonance frequencies, δν, and both broadened lines blend together into a very broad line. Coalescence of the two lines occurs when τ = (15.29) Example 15.2 Interpreting line broadening The NO group in N,N-dimethylnitrosamine, (CH3)2N-NO, rotates about the N-N bond and, as a result, the magnetic environments of the two CH3 groups are interchanged. The two CH3 resonances are separated by 390 Hz in a 600 MHz spectrometer. At what rate of interconversion will the resonance collapse to a single line? Method Use eqn 15.29 for the average lifetimes of the conformations. The rate of interconversion is the inverse of their lifetime. Answer With δν = 390 Hz, τ = = 1.2 ms 2 390 1 π ( )× − s 2 πδν 15.8 THE MAGNETIZATION VECTOR 533 It follows that the signal will collapse to a single line when the interconversion rate exceeds about 830 s−1 . The dependence of the rate of exchange on the temperature is used to determine the energy barrier to interconversion. Self-test 15.3 What would you deduce from the observation of a single line from the same molecule in a 300 MHz spectrometer? [Conformation lifetime less than 2.3 ms] A similar explanation accounts for the loss of fine structure in solvents able to exchange protons with the sample. For example, hydroxyl protons are able to exchange with water protons. When this chemical exchange occurs, a molecule ROH with an α-spin proton (we write this ROHα) rapidly converts to ROHβ and then perhaps to ROHα again because the protons provided by the solvent molecules in successive exchanges have random spin orientations. Therefore, instead of seeing a spectrum composed of contributions from both ROHα and ROHβ molecules (that is, a spectrum showing a doublet structure due to the OH proton) we see a spectrum that shows no splitting caused by coupling of the OH proton (as in Fig. 15.6). The effect is observed when the lifetime of a molecule due to this chemical exchange is so short that the lifetime broadening is greater than the doublet splitting. Because this splitting is often very small (a few hertz), a proton must remain attached to the same molecule for longer than about 0.1 s for the splitting to be observable. In water, the exchange rate is much faster than that, so alcohols show no splitting from the OH protons. In dry dimethylsulfoxide (DMSO), the exchange rate may be slow enough for the splitting to be detected. Pulse techniques in NMR Modern methods of detecting the energy separation between nuclear spin states are more sophisticated than simply looking for the frequency at which resonance occurs. One of the best analogies that has been suggested to illustrate the difference between the old and new ways of observing an NMR spectrum is that of detecting the spectrum of vibrations of a bell. We could stimulate the bell with a gentle vibration at a gradually increasing frequency, and note the frequencies at which it resonated with the stimulation. A lot of time would be spent getting zero response when the stimulating frequency was between the bell’s vibrational modes. However, if we were simply to hit the bell with a hammer, we would immediately obtain a clang composed of all the frequencies that the bell can produce. The equivalent in NMR is to monitor the radiation nuclear spins emit as they return to equilibrium after the appropriate stimulation. The resulting Fourier-transform NMR gives greatly increased sensitivity, so opening up the entire periodic table to the technique. Moreover, multiple-pulse FTNMR gives chemists unparalleled control over the information content and display of spectra. We need to understand how the equivalent of the hammer blow is delivered and how the signal is monitored and interpreted. These features are generally expressed in terms of the vector model of angular momentum introduced in Section 9.7d. 15.8 The magnetization vector Consider a sample composed of many identical spin-1 –2 nuclei. As we saw in Section 9.7d, an angular momentum can be represented by a vector of length {I(I + 1)}1/2 units 534 15 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 3: MAGNETIC RESONANCE with a component of length mI units along the z-axis. As the uncertainty principle does not allow us to specify the x- and y-components of the angular momentum, all we know is that the vector lies somewhere on a cone around the z-axis. For I = 1 –2, the length of the vector is 1 –2 3 and it makes an angle of 55° to the z-axis (Fig. 15.27). In the absence of a magnetic field, the sample consists of equal numbers of α and β nuclear spins with their vectors lying at random angles on the cones. These angles are unpredictable, and at this stage we picture the spin vectors as stationary. The magnetization, M, of the sample, its net nuclear magnetic moment, is zero (Fig. 15.28a). (a) The effect of the static field Two changes occur in the magnetization when a magnetic field is present. First, the energies of the two orientations change, the α spins moving to low energy and the β spins to high energy (provided γ > 0). At 10 T, the Larmor frequency for protons is 427 MHz, and in the vector model the individual vectors are pictured as precessing at this rate. This motion is a pictorial representation of the difference in energy of the spin states (it is not an actual representation of reality). As the field is increased, the Larmor frequency increases and the precession becomes faster. Secondly, the populations of the two spin states (the numbers of α and β spins) at thermal equilibrium change, and there will be more α spins than β spins. Because hνL/kT ≈ 7 × 10−5 for protons at 300 K and 10 T, it follows from the Boltzmann distribution that Nβ/Nα = e−hνL/kT is only slightly less than 1. That is, there is only a tiny imbalance of populations, and it is even smaller for other nuclei with their smaller magnetogyric ratios. However, despite its smallness, the imbalance means that there is a net magnetization that we can represent by a vector M pointing in the z-direction and with a length proportional to the population difference (Fig. 15.28b). (b) The effect of the radiofrequency field We now consider the effect of a radiofrequency field circularly polarized in the xyplane, so that the magnetic component of the electromagnetic field (the only component we need to consider) is rotating around the z-direction, the direction of the applied field B0, in the same sense as the Larmor precession. The strength of the rotating magnetic field is B1. Suppose we choose the frequency of this field to be equal to the Larmor frequency of the spins, νL = (γ/2π)B0; this choice is equivalent to selecting the resonance condition in the conventional experiment. The nuclei now experience a steady B1 field because the rotating magnetic field is in step with the precessing spins (Fig. 15.29a). Just as the spins precess about the strong static field B0 at a frequency γB0/2π, so under the influence of the field B1 they precess about B1 at a frequency γB1/2π. To interpret the effects of radiofrequency pulses on the magnetization, it is often useful to look at the spin system from a different perspective. If we were to imagine stepping on to a platform, a so-called rotating frame, that rotates around the direction of the applied field at the radiofrequency, then the nuclear magnetization appears stationary if the radiofrequency is the same as the Larmor frequency (Fig. 15.29b). If the B1 field is applied in a pulse of duration π/2γB1, the magnetization tips through 90° in the rotating frame and we say that we have applied a 90° pulse, or a ‘π/2 pulse’ (Fig. 15.30a). The duration of the pulse depends on the strength of the B1 field, but is typically of the order of microseconds. Now imagine stepping out of the rotating frame. To an external observer (the role played by a radiofrequency coil) in this stationary frame, the magnetization vector is now rotating at the Larmor frequency in the xy-plane (Fig. 15.30b). The rotating magnetization induces in the coil a signal that oscillates at the Larmor frequency and that + 3Ö z –2 1 –2 1 Fig. 15.27 The vector model of angular momentum for a single spin-1–2 nucleus. The angle around the z-axis is indeterminate. a a b b L Precession Net magnetization, M (a) (b) n Fig. 15.28 The magnetization of a sample of spin-1–2 nuclei is the resultant of all their magnetic moments. (a) In the absence of an externally applied field, there are equal numbers of α and β spins at random angles around the z-axis (the field direction) and the magnetization is zero. (b) In the presence of a field, the spins precess around their cones (that is, there is an energy difference between the α and β states) and there are slightly more α spins than β spins. As a result, there is a net magnetization along the z-axis. 15.8 THE MAGNETIZATION VECTOR 535 can be amplified and processed. In practice, the processing takes place after subtraction of a constant high frequency component (the radiofrequency used for B1), so that all the signal manipulation takes place at frequencies of a few kilohertz. As time passes, the individual spins move out of step (partly because they are precessing at slightly different rates, as we shall explain later), so the magnetization vector shrinks exponentially with a time constant T2 and induces an ever weaker signal in the detector coil. The form of the signal that we can expect is therefore the oscillatingdecaying free-induction decay (FID) shown in Fig. 15.31. The y-component of the magnetization varies as My(t) = M0 cos(2πνLt) e−t/T2 (15.30) We have considered the effect of a pulse applied at exactly the Larmor frequency. However, virtually the same effect is obtained off resonance, provided that the pulse is applied close to νL. If the difference in frequency is small compared to the inverse of the duration of the 90° pulse, the magnetization will end up in the xy-plane. Note that we do not need to know the Larmor frequency beforehand: the short pulse is the analogue of the hammer blow on the bell, exciting a range of frequencies. The detected signal shows that a particular resonant frequency is present. L = L B1B M M (a) (b) n n n B1B B1B M M (a) (b) 90° pulse Detecting coil L n B0B Fig. 15.30 (a) If the radiofrequency field is applied for a certain time, the magnetization vector is rotated into the xy-plane. (b) To an external stationary observer (the coil), the magnetization vector is rotating at the Larmor frequency, and can induce a signal in the coil. Time Signal Fig. 15.31 A simple free-induction decay of a sample of spins with a single resonance frequency. Fig. 15.29 (a) In a resonance experiment, a circularly polarized radiofrequency magnetic field B1 is applied in the xy-plane (the magnetization vector lies along the z-axis). (b) If we step into a frame rotating at the radiofrequency, B1 appears to be stationary, as does the magnetization M if the Larmor frequency is equal to the radiofrequency. When the two frequencies coincide, the magnetization vector of the sample rotates around the direction of the B1 field. 536 15 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 3: MAGNETIC RESONANCE (c) Time- and frequency-domain signals We can think of the magnetization vector of a homonuclear AX spin system with J = 0 as consisting of two parts, one formed by the A spins and the other by the X spins. When the 90° pulse is applied, both magnetization vectors are rotated into the xy-plane. However, because the A and X nuclei precess at different frequencies, they induce two signals in the detector coils, and the overall FID curve may resemble that in Fig. 15.32a. The composite FID curve is the analogue of the struck bell emitting a rich tone composed of all the frequencies at which it can vibrate. The problem we must address is how to recover the resonance frequencies present in a free-induction decay. We know that the FID curve is a sum of oscillating functions, so the problem is to analyse it into its component frequencies by carrying out a Fourier transformation (Further information 13.2 and 15.1). When the signal in Fig.15.32a is transformed in this way, we get the frequency-domain spectrum shown in Fig. 15.32b. One line represents the Larmor frequency of the A nuclei and the other that of the X nuclei. The FID curve in Fig. 15.33 is obtained from a sample of ethanol. The frequencydomain spectrum obtained from it by Fourier transformation is the one that we have already discussed (Fig. 15.6). We can now see why the FID curve in Fig. 15.33 is so complex: it arises from the precession of a magnetization vector that is composed of eight components, each with a characteristic frequency. 15.9 Spin relaxation There are two reasons why the component of the magnetization vector in the xy-plane shrinks. Both reflect the fact that the nuclear spins are not in thermal equilibrium with their surroundings (for then M lies parallel to z). The return to equilibrium is the process called spin relaxation. (a) Longitudinal and transverse relaxation At thermal equilibrium the spins have a Boltzmann distribution, with more α spins than β spins; however, a magnetization vector in the xy-plane immediately after a 90° pulse has equal numbers of α and β spins. Now consider the effect of a 180° pulse, which may be visualized in the rotating frame as a flip of the net magnetization vector from one direction along the z-axis to the opposite direction. That is, the 180° pulse leads to population inversion of the spin system, which now has more β spins than α spins. After the pulse, the populations revert to their thermal equilibrium values exponentially. As they do so, the z-component of magnetization reverts to its equilibrium value M0 with a time constant called the longitudinal relaxation time, T1 (Fig. 15.34): Mz(t) − M0 ∝ e−t/T1 (15.31) Because this relaxation process involves giving up energy to the surroundings (the ‘lattice’) as β spins revert to α spins, the time constant T1 is also called the spin–lattice relaxation time. Spin–lattice relaxation is caused by local magnetic fields that fluctuate at a frequency close to the resonance frequency of the α → β transition. Such fields can arise from the tumbling motion of molecules in a fluid sample. If molecular tumbling is too slow or too fast compared to the resonance frequency, it will give rise to a fluctuating magnetic field with a frequency that is either too low or too high to stimulate a spin change from β to α, so T1 will be long. Only if the molecule tumbles at about the resonance frequency will the fluctuating magnetic field be able to induce spin changes effectively, and only then will T1 be short. The rate of molecular tumbling Signal Time Frequency (a) (b) Fig. 15.32 (a) A free induction decay signal of a sample of AX species and (b) its analysis into its frequency components. Exploration The Living graphs section of the text’s web site has an applet that allows you to calculate and display the FID curve from an AX system. Explore the effect on the shape of the FID curve of changing the chemical shifts (and therefore the Larmor frequencies) of the A and X nuclei. Comment 15.6 The web site for this text contains links to databases of NMR spectra and to sites that allow for interactive simulation of NMR spectra. Signal Time, t Fig. 15.33 A free induction decay signal of a sample of ethanol. Its Fourier transform is the frequency-domain spectrum shown in Fig. 15.6. The total length of the image corresponds to about 1 s. 15.9 SPIN RELAXATION 537 increases with temperature and with reducing viscosity of the solvent, so we can expect a dependence like that shown in Fig. 15.35. A second aspect of spin relaxation is the fanning-out of the spins in the xy-plane if they precess at different rates (Fig. 15.36). The magnetization vector is large when all the spins are bunched together immediately after a 90° pulse. However, this orderly bunching of spins is not at equilibrium and, even if there were no spin–lattice relaxation, we would expect the individual spins to spread out until they were uniformly distributed with all possible angles around the z-axis. At that stage, the component of magnetization vector in the plane would be zero. The randomization of the spin directions occurs exponentially with a time constant called the transverse relaxation time, T2: My(t) ∝ e−t/T2 (15.32) t t T+ 1 b b a a Fig. 15.34 In longitudinal relaxation the spins relax back towards their thermal equilibrium populations. On the left we see the precessional cones representing spin-1–2 angular momenta, and they do not have their thermal equilibrium populations (there are more α-spins than β-spins). On the right, which represents the sample a long time after a time T1 has elapsed, the populations are those characteristic of a Boltzmann distribution (see Molecular interpretation 3.1). In actuality, T1 is the time constant for relaxation to the arrangement on the right and T1 ln 2 is the half-life of the arrangement on the left. Relaxationtime Rate of motion Low temperature, high viscosity High temperature, low viscosity T1 T2 Fig. 15.35 The variation of the two relaxation times with the rate at which the molecules move (either by tumbling or migrating through the solution). The horizontal axis can be interpreted as representing temperature or viscosity. Note that, at rapid rates of motion, the two relaxation times coincide. Fig. 15.36 The transverse relaxation time, T2, is the time constant for the phases of the spins to become randomized (another condition for equilibrium) and to change from the orderly arrangement shown on the left to the disorderly arrangement on the right (long after a time T2 has elapsed). Note that the populations of the states remain the same; only the relative phase of the spins relaxes. In actuality, T2 is the time constant for relaxation to the arrangement on the right and T2 ln 2 is the half-life of the arrangement on the left. 538 15 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 3: MAGNETIC RESONANCE Because the relaxation involves the relative orientation of the spins, T2 is also known as the spin–spin relaxation time. Any relaxation process that changes the balance between α and β spins will also contribute to this randomization, so the time constant T2 is almost always less than or equal to T1. Local magnetic fields also affect spin–spin relaxation. When the fluctuations are slow, each molecule lingers in its local magnetic environment and the spin orientations randomize quickly around the applied field direction. If the molecules move rapidly from one magnetic environment to another, the effects of differences in local magnetic field average to zero: individual spins do not precess at very different rates, they can remain bunched for longer, and spin–spin relaxation does not take place as quickly. In other words, slow molecular motion corresponds to short T2 and fast motion corresponds to long T2 (as shown in Fig. 15.35). Calculations show that, when the motion is fast, T2 ≈ T1. If the y-component of magnetization decays with a time constant T2, the spectral line is broadened (Fig. 15.37), and its width at half-height becomes ∆ν1/2 = (15.33) Typical values of T2 in proton NMR are of the order of seconds, so linewidths of around 0.1 Hz can be anticipated, in broad agreement with observation. So far, we have assumed that the equipment, and in particular the magnet, is perfect, and that the differences in Larmor frequencies arise solely from interactions within the sample. In practice, the magnet is not perfect, and the field is different at different locations in the sample. The inhomogeneity broadens the resonance, and in most cases this inhomogeneous broadening dominates the broadening we have discussed so far. It is common to express the extent of inhomogeneous broadening in terms of an effective transverse relaxation time, T2*, by using a relation like eqn 15.33, but writing T*2 = [15.34] where ∆ν1/2 is the observed width at half-height of a line with a Lorenztian shape of the form I ∝ 1/(1 + ν2 ). As an example, consider a line in a spectrum with a width of 10 Hz. It follows from eqn 15.34 that the effective transverse relaxation time is T*2 = = 32 ms (b) The measurement of T1 The longitudinal relaxation time T1 can be measured by the inversion recovery technique. The first step is to apply a 180° pulse to the sample. A 180° pulse is achieved by applying the B1 field for twice as long as for a 90° pulse, so the magnetization vector precesses through 180° and points in the −z-direction (Fig. 15.38). No signal can be seen at this stage because there is no component of magnetization in the xy-plane (where the coil can detect it). The β spins begin to relax back into α spins, and the magnetization vector first shrinks exponentially, falling through zero to its thermal equilibrium value, Mz. After an interval τ, a 90° pulse is applied that rotates the magnetization into the xy-plane, where it generates an FID signal. The frequency-domain spectrum is then obtained by Fourier transformation. 1 π × (10 s−1 ) 1 π∆ν1/2 1 πT2 1 0.8 0.6 0.4 0.2 0 0 Signalheight - 0 D p½ 2= 1/ T n n n Fig. 15.37 A Lorentzian absorption line. The width at half-height is inversely proportional to the parameter T2 and the longer the transverse relaxation time, the narrower the line. Exploration The Living graphs section of the text’s web site has an applet that allows you to calculate and display Lorenztian absorption lines. Explore the effect of the parameter T2 on the width and the maximal intensity of a Lorentzian line. Rationalize your observations. M B1 180° pulse 90° pulse Interval Relaxation from to -M M 0 0 Signal t Fig. 15.38 The result of applying a 180° pulse to the magnetization in the rotating frame and the effect of a subsequent 90° pulse. The amplitude of the frequency-domain spectrum varies with the interval between the two pulses because spin–lattice relaxation has time to occur. 15.9 SPIN RELAXATION 539 The intensity of the spectrum obtained in this way depends on the length of the magnetization vector that is rotated into the xy-plane. The length of that vector changes exponentially as the interval between the two pulses is increased, so the intensity of the spectrum also changes exponentially with increasing τ. We can therefore measure T1 by fitting an exponential curve to the series of spectra obtained with different values of τ. (c) Spin echoes The measurement of T2 (as distinct from T2*) depends on being able to eliminate the effects of inhomogeneous broadening. The cunning required is at the root of some of the most important advances that have been made in NMR since its introduction. A spin echo is the magnetic analogue of an audible echo: transverse magnetization is created by a radiofrequency pulse, decays away, is reflected by a second pulse, and grows back to form an echo. The sequence of events is shown in Fig. 15.39. We can consider the overall magnetization as being made up of a number of different magnetizations, each of which arises from a spin packet of nuclei with very similar precession frequencies. The spread in these frequencies arises because the applied field B0 is inhomogeneous, so different parts of the sample experience different fields. The precession frequencies also differ if there is more than one chemical shift present. As will be seen, the importance of a spin echo is that it can suppress the effects of both field inhomogeneities and chemical shifts. First, a 90° pulse is applied to the sample. We follow events by using the rotating frame, in which B1 is stationary along the x-axis and causes the magnetization to be into the xy-plane. The spin packets now begin to fan out because they have different Larmor frequencies, with some above the radiofrequency and some below. The detected signal depends on the resultant of the spin-packet magnetization vectors, and decays with a time-constant T2* because of the combined effects of field inhomogeneity and spin–spin relaxation. After an evolution period τ, a 180° pulse is applied to the sample; this time, about the y-axis of the rotating frame (the axis of the pulse is changed from x to y by a 90° phase shift of the radiofrequency radiation). The pulse rotates the magnetization vectors of the faster spin packets into the positions previously occupied by the slower spin packets, and vice versa. Thus, as the vectors continue to precess, the fast vectors are now behind the slow; the fan begins to close up again, and the resultant signal begins to grow back into an echo. At time 2τ, all the vectors will once more be aligned along the y-axis, and the fanning out caused by the field inhomogeneity is said to have been refocused: the spin echo has reached its maximum. Because the effects of field inhomogeneities have been suppressed by the refocusing, the echo signal will have been attenuated by the factor e−2τ/T2 caused by spin–spin relaxation alone. After the time 2τ, the magnetization will continue to precess, fanning out once again, giving a resultant that decays with time constant T2*. The important feature of the technique is that the size of the echo is independent of any local fields that remain constant during the two τ intervals. If a spin packet is ‘fast’ because it happens to be composed of spins in a region of the sample that experiences higher than average fields, then it remains fast throughout both intervals, and what it gains on the first interval it loses on the second interval. Hence, the size of the echo is independent of inhomogeneities in the magnetic field, for these remain constant. The true transverse relaxation arises from fields that vary on a molecular distance scale, and there is no guarantee that an individual ‘fast’ spin will remain ‘fast’ in the refocusing phase: the spins within the packets therefore spread with a time constant T2. Hence, the effects of the true relaxation are not refocused, and the size of the echo decays with the time constant T2 (Fig. 15.40). 90° pulse M x y z Fast spinsSlow spins 180° pulse Refocused magnetization t t Fast spins Slow spins Fig. 15.39 The sequence of pulses leading to the observation of a spin echo. e - /T t Echo t 2 Fig. 15.40 The exponential decay of spin echoes can be used to determine the transverse relaxation time. 540 15 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 3: MAGNETIC RESONANCE IMPACT ON MEDICINE I15.1 Magnetic resonance imaging One of the most striking applications of nuclear magnetic resonance is in medicine. Magnetic resonance imaging (MRI) is a portrayal of the concentrations of protons in a solid object. The technique relies on the application of specific pulse sequences to an object in an inhomogeneous magnetic field. If an object containing hydrogen nuclei (a tube of water or a human body) is placed in an NMR spectrometer and exposed to a homogeneous magnetic field, then a single resonance signal will be detected. Now consider a flask of water in a magnetic field that varies linearly in the z-direction according to B0 + Gzz, where Gz is the field gradient along the z-direction (Fig. 15.41). Then the water protons will be resonant at the frequencies νL(z) = (B0 + Gzz) (15.35) (Similar equations may be written for gradients along the x- and y-directions.) Application of a 90° radiofrequency pulse with ν = νL(z) will result in a signal with an intensity that is proportional to the numbers of protons at the position z. This is an example of slice selection, the application of a selective 90° pulse that excites nuclei in a specific region, or slice, of the sample. It follows that the intensity of the NMR signal will be a projection of the numbers of protons on a line parallel to the field gradient. The image of a three-dimensional object such as a flask of water can be obtained if the slice selection technique is applied at different orientations (see Fig. 15.41). In projection reconstruction, the projections can be analysed on a computer to reconstruct the three-dimensional distribution of protons in the object. In practice, the NMR signal is not obtained by direct analysis of the FID curve after application of a single 90° pulse. Instead, spin echoes are often detected with several variations of the 90°–τ–180° pulse sequence (Section 15.9c). In phase encoding, field gradients are applied during the evolution period and the detection period of a spin-echo pulse sequence. The first step consists of a 90° pulse that results in slice selection along the z-direction. The second step consists of application of a phase gradient, a field gradient along the y-direction, during the evolution period. At each position along the gradient, a spin packet will precess at a different Larmor frequency due to chemical shift effects and the field inhomogeneity, so each packet will dephase to a different extent by the end of the evolution period. We can control the extent of dephasing by changing the duration of the evolution period, so Fourier transformation on τ gives information about the location of a proton along the y-direction.1 For each value of τ, the next steps are application of the 180° pulse and then of a read gradient, a field gradient along the x-direction, during detection of the echo. Protons at different positions along x experience different fields and will resonate at different frequencies. Therefore Fourier transformation of the FID gives different signals for protons at different positions along x. A common problem with the techniques described above is image contrast, which must be optimized in order to show spatial variations in water content in the sample. One strategy for solving this problem takes advantage of the fact that the relaxation times of water protons are shorter for water in biological tissues than for the pure liquid. Furthermore, relaxation times from water protons are also different in healthy anddiseasedtissues.AT1-weightedimageisobtainedbyrepeatingthespinechosequence γ 2π Magnetic field Magnetic field Signal Sample Fig. 15.41 In a magnetic field that varies linearly over a sample, all the protons within a given slice (that is, at a given field value) come into resonance and give a signal of the corresponding intensity. The resulting intensity pattern is a map of the numbers in all the slices, and portrays the shape of the sample. Changing the orientation of the field shows the shape along the corresponding direction, and computer manipulation can be used to build up the three-dimensional shape of the sample. 1 For technical reasons, it is more common to vary the magnitude of the phase gradient. See Further reading for details. 15.10 SPIN DECOUPLING 541 before spin–lattice relaxation can return the spins in the sample to equilibrium. Under these conditions, differences in signal intensities are directly related to differences in T1. A T2-weighted image is obtained by using an evolution period τ that is relatively long. Each point on the image is an echo signal that behaves in the manner shown in Fig. 15.40, so signal intensities are strongly dependent on variations in T2. However, allowing so much of the decay to occur leads to weak signals even for those protons with long spin–spin relaxation times. Another strategy involves the use of contrast agents, paramagnetic compounds that shorten the relaxation times of nearby protons. The technique is particularly useful in enhancing image contrast and in diagnosing disease if the contrast agent is distributed differently in healthy and diseased tissues. The MRI technique is used widely to detect physiological abnormalities and to observe metabolic processes. With functional MRI, blood flow in different regions of the brain can be studied and related to the mental activities of the subject. The technique is based on differences in the magnetic properties of deoxygenated and oxygenated haemoglobin, the iron-containing protein that transports O2 in red blood cells. The more paramagnetic deoxygenated haemoglobin affects the proton resonances of tissue differently from the oxygenated protein. Because there is greater blood flow in active regions of the brain than in inactive regions, changes in the intensities of proton resonances due to changes in levels of oxygenated haemoglobin can be related to brain activity. The special advantage of MRI is that it can image soft tissues (Fig. 15.42), whereas X-rays are largely used for imaging hard, bony structures and abnormally dense regions, such as tumours. In fact, the invisibility of hard structures in MRI is an advantage, as it allows the imaging of structures encased by bone, such as the brain and the spinal cord. X-rays are known to be dangerous on account of the ionization they cause; the high magnetic fields used in MRI may also be dangerous but, apart from anecdotes about the extraction of loose fillings from teeth, there is no convincing evidence of their harmfulness, and the technique is considered safe. 15.10 Spin decoupling Carbon-13 is a dilute-spin species in the sense that it is unlikely that more than one 13 C nucleus will be found in any given small molecule (provided the sample has not been enriched with that isotope; the natural abundance of 13 C is only 1.1 per cent). Even in large molecules, although more than one 13 C nucleus may be present, it is unlikely that they will be close enough to give an observable splitting. Hence, it is not normally necessary to take into account 13 C-13 C spin–spin coupling within a molecule. Protons are abundant-spin species in the sense that a molecule is likely to contain many of them. If we were observing a 13 C-NMR spectrum, we would obtain a very complex spectrum on account of the coupling of the one 13 C nucleus with many of the protons that are present. To avoid this difficulty, 13 C-NMR spectra are normally observed using the technique of proton decoupling. Thus, if the CH3 protons of ethanol are irradiated with a second, strong, resonant radiofrequency pulse, they undergo rapid spin reorientations and the 13 C nucleus senses an average orientation. As a result, its resonance is a single line and not a 1:3:3:1 quartet. Proton decoupling has the additional advantage of enhancing sensitivity, because the intensity is concentrated into a single transition frequency instead of being spread over several transition frequencies (see Section 15.11). If care is taken to ensure that the other parameters on which the strength of the signal depends are kept constant, the intensities of proton-decoupled spectra are proportional to the number of 13 C nuclei present. The technique is widely used to characterize synthetic polymers. Fig. 15.42 The great advantage of MRI is that it can display soft tissue, such as in this cross-section through a patient’s head. (Courtesy of the University of Manitoba.) 542 15 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 3: MAGNETIC RESONANCE 15.11 The nuclear Overhauser effect We have seen already that one advantage of protons in NMR is their high magnetogyric ratio, which results in relatively large Boltzmann population differences and hence greater resonance intensities than for most other nuclei. In the steady-state nuclear Overhauser effect (NOE), spin relaxation processes involving internuclear dipole– dipole interactions are used to transfer this population advantage to another nucleus (such as 13 C or another proton), so that the latter’s resonances are modified. To understand the effect, we consider the populations of the four levels of a homonuclear (for instance, proton) AX system; these were shown in Fig. 15.12. At thermal equilibrium, the population of the αAαX level is the greatest, and that of the βAβX level is the least; the other two levels have the same energy and an intermediate population. The thermal equilibrium absorption intensities reflect these populations as shown in Fig. 15.43. Now consider the combined effect of spin relaxation and keeping the X spins saturated. When we saturate the X transition, the populations of the X levels are equalized (NαX = NβX) and all transitions involving αX ↔ βX spin flips are no longer observed. At this stage there is no change in the populations of the A levels. If that were all there were to happen, all we would see would be the loss of the X resonance and no effect on the A resonance. Now consider the effect of spin relaxation. Relaxation can occur in a variety of ways if there is a dipolar interaction between the A and X spins. One possibility is for the magnetic field acting between the two spins to cause them both to flop from β to α, so the αAαX and βAβX states regain their thermal equilibrium populations. However, the populations of the αAβX and βAαX levels remain unchanged at the values characteristic of saturation. As we see from Fig. 15.44, the population difference between the states joined by transitions of A is now greater than at equilibrium, so the resonance absorption is enhanced. Another possibility is for the dipolar interaction between the two spins to cause αto flip to βand βto flop to α. This transition equilibrates the populations of αAβX and βAαX but leaves the αAαX and βAβX populations unchanged. Now we see from the illustration that the population differences in the states involved in the A transitions are decreased, so the resonance absorption is diminished. Which effect wins? Does the NOE enhance the A absorption or does it diminish it? As in the discussion of relaxation times in Section 15.9, the efficiency of the intensityenhancing βAβX ↔ αAαX relaxation is high if the dipole field oscillates at a frequency close to the transition frequency, which in this case is about 2ν; likewise, the efficiency Comment 15.7 In a dipole–dipole interaction between two nuclei, one nucleus influences the behaviour of another nucleus in much the same way that the orientation of a bar magnet is influenced by the presence of another bar magnet nearby. Dipole–dipole interactions are discussed in Chapter 18. Energy A X A A X X a b A X b a A Xa a A Xb b Fig. 15.43 The energy levels of an AX system and an indication of their relative populations. Each grey square above the line represents an excess population and each white square below the line represents a population deficit. The transitions of A and X are marked. Energy A X A A A A A A X XX X XX Saturate Saturate Relax Enhance Enhance (a) (b) (c) b b A Xa a A Xb aA Xa b A Xb b A Xa a A Xb aA Xa b A Xb b A Xa a A Xb aA Xa b Fig. 15.44 (a) When the X transition is saturated, the populations of its two states are equalized and the population excess and deficit become as shown (using the same symbols as in Fig. 15.43). (b) Dipole–dipole relaxation relaxes the populations of the highest and lowest states, and they regain their original populations. (c) The A transitions reflect the difference in populations resulting from the preceding changes, and are enhanced compared with those shown in Fig. 15.43. 15.11 THE NUCLEAR OVERHAUSER EFFECT 543 of the intensity-diminishing αAβX ↔ βAαX relaxation is high if the dipole field is stationary (as there is no frequency difference between the initial and final states). A large molecule rotates so slowly that there is very little motion at 2ν, so we expect an intensity decrease (Fig. 15.45). A small molecule rotating rapidly can be expected to have substantial motion at 2ν, and a consequent enhancement of the signal. In practice, the enhancement lies somewhere between the two extremes and is reported in terms of the parameter η (eta), where η = [15.36] Here IA° and IA are the intensities of the NMR signals due to nucleus A before and after application of the long (> T1) radiofrequency pulse that saturates transitions due to the X nucleus. When A and X are nuclei of the same species, such as protons, η lies between −1 (diminution) and +1 –2 (enhancement). However, η also depends on the values of the magnetogyric ratios of A and X. In the case of maximal enhancement it is possible to show that η = (15.37) where γA and γX are the magnetogyric ratios of nuclei A and X, respectively. For 13 C close to a saturated proton, the ratio evaluates to 1.99, which shows that an enhancement of about a factor of 2 can be achieved. The NOE is also used to determine interproton distances. The Overhauser enhancement of a proton A generated by saturating a spin X depends on the fraction of A’s spin–lattice relaxation that is caused by its dipolar interaction with X. Because the dipolar field is proportional to r−3 , where r is the internuclear distance, and the relaxation effect is proportional to the square of the field, and therefore to r−6 , the NOE may be used to determine the geometries of molecules in solution. The determination of the structure of a small protein in solution involves the use of several hundred NOE measurements, effectively casting a net over the protons present. The enormous importance of this procedure is that we can determine the conformation of biological macromolecules in an aqueous environment and do not need to try to make the single crystals that are essential for an X-ray diffraction investigation (Chapter 20). γX 2γA IA − IA° IA° Energy A A A A A A X XX X XX Saturate Saturate Relax (a) (b) (c) Diminish Diminish A Xb b A Xa a A Xb aA Xa b A Xb b A Xa a A Xb a A Xa b A Xb b A Xa a A Xb a A Xa b Fig. 15.45 (a) When the X transition is saturated, just as in Fig. 15.44 the populations of its two states are equalized and the population excess and deficit become as shown. (b) Dipole–dipole relaxation relaxes the populations of the two intermediate states, and they regain their original populations. (c) The A transitions reflect the difference in populations resulting from the preceding changes, and are diminished compared with those shown in Fig. 15.41. 544 15 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 3: MAGNETIC RESONANCE 15.12 Two-dimensional NMR An NMR spectrum contains a great deal of information and, if many protons are present, is very complex. Even a first-order spectrum is complex, for the fine structure of different groups of lines can overlap. The complexity would be reduced if we could use two axes to display the data, with resonances belonging to different groups lying at different locations on the second axis. This separation is essentially what is achieved in two-dimensional NMR. All two-dimensional NMR experiments use the PEMDpulsestructure, which consists of: P: a preparation period, in which the spins first return to thermal equilibrium and then are excited by one or more radiofrequency pulses E: an evolution period of duration t1, during which the spins precess under the influence of their chemical shifts and spin–spin couplings M: a mixing period, in which pulses may be used to transfer information between spins D: a detection period of duration t2, during which the FID is recorded. Now we shall see how the PEMD pulse structure can be used to devise experiments that reveal spin–spin couplings and internuclear distances in small and large molecules. (a) Correlation spectroscopy Much modern NMR work makes use of techniques such as correlation spectroscopy (COSY) in which a clever choice of pulses and Fourier transformation techniques makes it possible to determine all spin–spin couplings in a molecule. The basic COSY experiment uses the simplest of all two-dimensional pulse sequences, consisting of two consecutive 90° pulses (Fig. 15.46). To see how we can obtain a two-dimensional spectrum from a COSY experiment, we consider a trivial but illustrative example: the spectrum of a compound containing one proton, such as trichloromethane (chloroform, CHCl3). Figure 15.47 shows the effect of the pulse sequence on the magnetization of the sample, which is aligned initially along the z-axis with a magnitude M0. A 90° pulse applied in the x-direction (in the stationary frame) tilts the magnetization vector toward the y-axis. Then, during the evolution period, the magnetization vector rotates in the xy-plane with a frequency ν. At a time t1 the vector will have swept through an angle 2πνt1 and the magnitude of the magnetization will have decayed by spin–spin relaxation to M = M0e−t1/T2 . By trigonometry, the magnitudes of the components of the magnetization vector are: Mx = M sin 2πνt1 My = M cos 2πνt1 Mz = 0 (15.38a) Application of the second 90° pulse parallel to the x-axis tilts the magnetization again and the resulting vector has components with magnitudes (once again, in the stationary frame) Mx = M sin 2πνt1 My = 0 Mz = M cos 2πνt1 (15.38b) The FID is detected over a period t2 and Fourier transformation yields a signal over a frequency range ν2 with a peak at ν, the resonance frequency of the proton. The signal intensity is related to Mx, the magnitude of the magnetization that is rotating around the xy-plane at the time of application of the detection pulse, so it follows that the signal strength varies sinusoidally with the duration of the evolution period. That is, if we were to acquire a series of spectra at different evolution times t1, then we would obtain data as shown in Fig. 15.48a. Time Preparation period Evolution periodt1 Detection periodt2 90 pulse o 90 pulse o P E M D Fig. 15.46 The pulse sequence used in correlation spectroscopy (COSY). The preparation period is much longer than either T1 or T2, so the spins have time to relax before the next cycle of pulses begins. Acquisitions of free-induction decays are taken during t2 for a set of different evolution times t1. Fourier transformation on both variables t1 and t2 results in a twodimensional spectrum, such as that shown in Fig 15.52. Comment 15.8 A vector, V, of length 1, in the xy-plane and its two components, 1x and 1y, can be thought of as forming a right-angled triangle, with 1 the length of the hypotenuse (see the illustration). If q is the angle that 1y makes with 1, then it follows that 1x = 1 sin q and 1y = 1 cos q. 15.12 TWO-DIMENSIONAL NMR 545 A plot of the maximum intensity of each absorption band in Fig. 15.48a against t1 has the form shown in Fig. 15.48b. The plot resembles an FID curve with the oscillating component having a frequency ν, so Fourier transformation yields a signal over a frequency range ν1 with a peak at ν. If we continue the process by first plotting signal intensity against t1 for several frequencies along the ν2 axis and then carrying out Fourier transformations, we generate a family of curves that can be pooled together into a three-dimensional plot of I(ν1,ν2), the signal intensity as a function of the frequencies ν1 and ν2 (Fig. 15.49a). This plot is referred to as a two-dimensional NMR spectrum because Fourier transformations were performed in two variables. The most common representation of the data is as a contour plot, such as the one shown in Fig. 15.49b. The experiment described above is not necessary for as simple a system as chloroform because the information contained in the two-dimensional spectrum could have been obtained much more quickly through the conventional, one-dimensional approach. However,whentheone-dimensionalspectrumiscomplex,theCOSYexperimentshows which spins are related by spin–spin coupling. To justify this statement, we now examine a spin-coupled AX system. From our discussion so far, we know that the key to the COSY technique is the effect of the second 90° pulse. In this more complex example we consider its role for the four energy levels of an AX system (as shown in Fig. 15.12). At thermal equilibrium, the population of the αAαX level is the greatest, and that of the βAβX level is the least; the other two levels have the same energy and an intermediate population. After the first 90° pulse, the spins are no longer at thermal equilibrium. If a second 90° pulse M0 (a) x y z (b) x y z 90 pulseo M0 (c) x y z t1 M tcos 2p 1 M 2p t1 (d) x y z 90 pulseo M tsin 2p 1 M tcos 2p 1 M tsin 2p 1n n n n n 2 t1 (b) t1 Intensity (a) n 2 1 (a) (b) 2 1 n nn n n n Fig. 15.47 (a) The effect of the pulse sequence shown in Fig. 15.46 on the magnetization M0 of a sample of a compound with only one proton. (b) A 90° pulse applied in the x-direction tilts the magnetization vector toward the y-axis. (c) After a time t1 has elapsed, the vector will have swept through an angle 2πνt1 and the magnitude of the magnetization will have decayed to M. The magnitudes of the components of M are Mx = M sin 2πνt1, My = M cos 2πνt1, and Mz = 0. (d) Application of the second 90° pulse parallel to the x-axis tilts the magnetization again and the resulting vector has components with magnitude Mx = M sin 2πνt1, My = 0, and Mz = M cos 2πνt1. The FID is detected at this stage of the experiment. Fig. 15.48 (a) Spectra acquired for different evolution times t1 between two 90° pulses. (b) A plot of the maximum intensity of each absorption line against t1. Fourier transformation of this plot leads to a spectrum centred at ν, the resonance frequency of the protons in the sample. Fig. 15.49 (a) The two-dimensional NMR spectrum of the sample discussed in Figs. 15.47 and 15.48. See the text for an explanation of how the spectrum is obtained from a series of Fourier transformations of the data. (b) The contour plot of the spectrum in (a). 546 15 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 3: MAGNETIC RESONANCE is applied at a time t1 that is short compared to the spin–lattice relaxation time T1, the extra input of energy causes further changes in the populations of the four states. The changes in populations of the four states of the AX system will depend on how far the individual magnetizations have precessed during the evolution period. It is difficult to visualize these changes because the A spins are affecting the X spins and vice-versa. Forsimplicity,weimaginethatthesecondpulseinducesXandAtransitionssequentially. Depending on the evolution time t1, the 90° pulse may leave the population differences across each of the two X transitions unchanged, inverted, or somewhere in between. Consider the extreme case in which one population difference is inverted and the other unchanged (Fig. 15.50). Excitation of the A transitions will now generate an FID in which one of the two A transitions has increased in intensity (because the population difference is now greater), and the other has decreased (because the population difference is now smaller). The overall effect is that precession of the X spins during the evolution period determines the amplitudes of the signals from the A spins obtained during the detection period. As the evolution time t1 is increased, the intensities of the signals from A spins oscillate with frequencies determined by the frequencies of the two X transitions. Of course, it is just as easy to turn our scenario around and to conclude that the intensities of signals from X spins oscillate with frequencies determined by the frequencies of the A transitions. This transfer of information between spins is at the heart of two-dimensional NMR spectroscopy: it leads to the correlation between different signals in a spectrum. In this case, information transfer tells us that there is spin–spin coupling between A and X. So, just as before, if we conduct a series of experiments in which t1 is incremented, Fourier transformation of the FIDs on t2 yields a set of spectra I(t1,F2) in which the signal amplitudes oscillate as a function of t1. A second Fourier transformation, now on t1, converts these oscillations into a two-dimensional spectrum I(F1,F2). The signals are spread out in F1 according to their precession frequencies during the detection period. Thus, if we apply the COSY pulse sequence (Fig. 15.46) to the AX spin system, the result is a two-dimensional spectrum that contains four groups of signals in F1 and F2 centred on the two chemical shifts (Fig. 15.51). Each group consists of a block of four signals separated by J. The diagonal peaks are signals centred on (δA,δA) and (δX,δX) and lie along the diagonal F1 = F2. That is, the spectrum along the diagonal is equivalent to the one-dimensional spectrum obtained with the conventional NMR technique (Fig. 15.13). The cross-peaks (or off-diagonal peaks) are signals centred on (δA,δX) and (δX,δA) and owe their existence to the coupling between A and X. Although information from two-dimensional NMR spectroscopy is trivial in an AX system, it can be of enormous help in the interpretation of more complex spectra, leading to a map of the couplings between spins and to the determination of the bonding network in complex molecules. Indeed, the spectrum of a synthetic or biological polymer that would be impossible to interpret in one-dimensional NMR but can often be interpreted reasonably rapidly by two-dimensional NMR. Below we illustrate the procedure by assigning the resonances in the COSY spectrum of an amino acid. X transition A transition A transition FID A Xb b A Xb a A Xb a A Xba A Xb b A XaaA Xaa A Xba X transition Fig. 15.50 An example of the change in the population of energy levels of an AX spin system that results from the second 90° pulse of a COSY experiment. Each square represents the same large number of spins. In this example, we imagine that the pulse affects the X spins first, and then the A spins. Excitation of the X spins inverts the populations of the βAβX and βAαX levels and does not affect the populations of the αAαX and αAβX levels. As a result, excitation of the A spins by the pulse generates an FID in which one of the two A transitions has increased in intensity and the other has decreased. That is, magnetization has been transferred from the X spins to the A spins. Similar schemes can be written to show that magnetization can be transferred from the A spins to the X spins. d d Fig. 15.51 A representation of the twodimensional NMR spectrum obtained by application of the COSY pulse sequence to an AX spin system. 15.12 TWO-DIMENSIONAL NMR 547 d 4.0 d 3.0 2.0 1.0 3.0 2.0 1.0 Fig. 15.52 Proton COSY spectrum of isoleucine. (Adapted from K.E. van Holde, W.C. Johnson, and P.S. Ho, Principles of physical biochemistry, p. 508, Prentice Hall, Upper Saddle River (1998).) Illustration 15.3 The COSY spectrum of isoleucine Figure 15.52 is a portion of the COSY spectrum of the amino acid isoleucine (7), showing the resonances associated with the protons bound to the carbon atoms. We begin the assignment process by considering which protons should be interacting by spin–spin coupling. From the known molecular structure, we conclude that: 1. The Ca-H proton is coupled only to the Cb-H proton. 2. The Cb-H protons are coupled to the Ca-H, Cc-H, and Cd-H protons. 3. The inequivalent Cd-H protons are coupled to the Cb-H and Ce-H protons. We now note that: • The resonance with δ = 3.6 shares a cross-peak with only one other resonance at δ = 1.9, which in turn shares cross-peaks with resonances at δ = 1.4, 1.2, and 0.9. This identification is consistent with the resonances at δ = 3.6 and 1.9 corresponding to the Ca-H and Cb-H protons, respectively. • The proton with resonance at δ = 0.8 is not coupled to the Cb-H protons, so we assign the resonance at δ = 0.8 to the Ce-H protons. • The resonances at δ = 1.4 and 1.2 do not share cross-peaks with the resonance at δ = 0.9. In the light of the expected couplings, we assign the resonance at δ = 0.9 to the Cc-H protons and the resonances at δ = 1.4 and 1.2 to the inequivalent Cd-H protons. Our simplified description of the COSY experiment does not reveal some important details. For example, the second 90° pulse actually mixes the spin state transitions caused by the first 90° pulse (hence the term ‘mixing period’). Each of the four transitions (two for A and two for X) generated by the first pulse can be converted into any of the other three, or into formally forbidden multiple quantum transitions, which have |∆m| > 1. The latter transitions cannot generate any signal in the receiver coil of the spectrometer, but their existence can be demonstrated by applying a third pulse to mix them back into the four observable single quantum transitions. Many modern NMR experiments exploit multiple quantum transitions to filter out unwanted signals and to simplify spectra for interpretation. 548 15 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 3: MAGNETIC RESONANCE (b) Nuclear Overhauser effect spectroscopy Many different two-dimensional NMR experiments are based on the PEMD pulse structure. We have seen that the steady-state nuclear Overhauser effect can provide information about internuclear distances through analysis of enhancement patterns in the NMR spectrum before and after saturation of selected resonances. In its dynamic analogue, nuclear Overhauser effect spectroscopy (NOESY), the second 90° pulse of the COSY experiment is replaced by two 90° pulses separated by a time delay during which dipole–dipole interactions cause magnetization to be exchanged between neighbouring spins (Fig. 15.50). The results of double Fourier transformation is a spectrum in which the cross-peaks form a map of all the NOE interactions in a molecule. Because the nuclear Overhauser effect depends on the inverse sixth power of the separation between nuclei (see Section 15.11), NOESY data reveal internuclear distances up to about 0.5 nm. 15.13 Solid-state NMR The principal difficulty with the application of NMR to solids is the low resolution characteristic of solid samples. Nevertheless, there are good reasons for seeking to overcome these difficulties. They include the possibility that a compound of interest is unstable in solution or that it is insoluble, so conventional solution NMR cannot be employed. Moreover, many species are intrinsically interesting as solids, and it is important to determine their structures and dynamics. Synthetic polymers are particularly interesting in this regard, and information can be obtained about the arrangement of molecules, their conformations, and the motion of different parts of the chain. This kind of information is crucial to an interpretation of the bulk properties of the polymer in terms of its molecular characteristics. Similarly, inorganic substances, such as the zeolites that are used as molecular sieves and shape-selective catalysts, can be studied using solid-state NMR, and structural problems can be resolved that cannot be tackled by X-ray diffraction. Problems of resolution and linewidth are not the only features that plague NMR studies of solids, but the rewards are so great that considerable efforts have been made to overcome them and have achieved notable success. Because molecular rotation has almost ceased (except in special cases, including ‘plastic crystals’ in which the molecules continue to tumble), spin–lattice relaxation times are very long but spin–spin relaxation times are very short. Hence, in a pulse experiment, there is a need for lengthy delays—of several seconds—between successive pulses so that the spin system has time to revert to equilibrium. Even gathering the murky information may therefore be a lengthy process. Moreover, because lines are so broad, very high powers of radiofrequency radiation may be required to achieve saturation. Whereas solution pulse NMR uses transmitters of a few tens of watts, solid-state NMR may require transmitters rated at several hundreds of watts. (a) The origins of linewidths in solids There are two principal contributions to the linewidths of solids. One is the direct magnetic dipolar interaction between nuclear spins. As we saw in the discussion of spin–spin coupling, a nuclear magnetic moment will give rise to a local magnetic field, which points in different directions at different locations around the nucleus. If we are interested only in the component parallel to the direction of the applied magnetic field (because only this component has a significant effect), then we can use a classical expression to write the magnitude of the local magnetic field as 15.14 THE EPR SPECTROMETER 549 Bloc = − (1 – 3 cos2 θ) (15.39) Unlike in solution, this field is not motionally averaged to zero. Many nuclei may contribute to the total local field experienced by a nucleus of interest, and different nuclei in a sample may experience a wide range of fields. Typical dipole fields are of the order of 10−3 T, which corresponds to splittings and linewidths of the order of 104 Hz. A second source of linewidth is the anisotropy of the chemical shift. We have seen that chemical shifts arise from the ability of the applied field to generate electron currents in molecules. In general, this ability depends on the orientation of the molecule relative to the applied field. In solution, when the molecule is tumbling rapidly, only the average value of the chemical shift is relevant. However, the anisotropy is not averaged to zero for stationary molecules in a solid, and molecules in different orientations have resonances at different frequencies. The chemical shift anisotropy also varies with the angle between the applied field and the principal axis of the molecule as 1 – 3 cos2 θ. (b) The reduction of linewidths Fortunately, there are techniques available for reducing the linewidths of solid samples. One technique, magic-angle spinning (MAS), takes note of the 1 – 3 cos2 θ depend- enceofboththedipole–dipoleinteractionandthechemicalshiftanisotropy.The‘magic angle’ is the angle at which 1 – 3 cos2 θ = 0, and corresponds to 54.74°. In the technique, the sample is spun at high speed at the magic angle to the applied field (Fig. 15.53). All the dipolar interactions and the anisotropies average to the value they would have at the magic angle, but at that angle they are zero. The difficulty with MAS is that the spinning frequency must not be less than the width of the spectrum, which is of the order of kilohertz. However, gas-driven sample spinners that can be rotated at up to 25 kHz are now routinely available, and a considerable body of work has been done. Pulsed techniques similar to those described in the previous section may also be used to reduce linewidths. The dipolar field of protons, for instance, may be reduced byadecouplingprocedure.However,becausetherangeofcouplingstrengthsissolarge, radiofrequency power of the order of 1 kW is required. Elaborate pulse sequences have also been devised that reduce linewidths by averaging procedures that make use of twisting the magnetization vector through an elaborate series of angles. Electron paramagnetic resonance Electron paramagnetic resonance (EPR) is less widely applicable than NMR because it cannot be detected in normal, spin-paired molecules and the sample must possess unpaired electron spins. It is used to study radicals formed during chemical reactions or by radiation, radicals that act as probes of biological structure, many d-metal complexes, and molecules in triplet states (such as those involved in phosphorescence, Section 14.3b). The sample may be a gas, a liquid, or a solid, but the free rotation of molecules in the gas phase gives rise to complications. 15.14 The EPR spectrometer Both Fourier-transform (FT) and continuous wave (CW) EPR spectrometers are available. The FT-EPR instrument is based on the concepts developed in Section 15.8, except that pulses of microwaves are used to excite electron spins in the sample. The layout of the more common CW-EPR spectrometer is shown in Fig. 15.54. It consists γ $µ0mI 4πR3 54.74° Magnetic field 54.74° Fig. 15.53 In magic angle spinning, the sample spins at 54.74° (that is, arccos (1–3)1/2 ) to the applied magnetic field. Rapid motion at this angle averages dipole–dipole interactions and chemical shift anisotropies to zero. Microwave source Detector Modulation input Electro- magnet Phase- sensitive detector Sample cavity Fig. 15.54 The layout of a continuous-wave EPR spectrometer. A typical magnetic field is 0.3 T, which requires 9 GHz (3 cm) microwaves for resonance. 550 15 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 3: MAGNETIC RESONANCE Field strength a Absorption, A First derivative of absorption, d /dA B Slope Field, B Fig. 15.55 The EPR spectrum of the benzene radical anion, C6H6 − , in fluid solution. a is the hyperfine splitting of the spectrum; the centre of the spectrum is determined by the g-value of the radical. Fig. 15.56 When phase-sensitive detection is used, the signal is the first derivative of the absorption intensity. Note that the peak of the absorption corresponds to the point where the derivative passes through zero. Fig. 15.57 An applied magnetic field can induce circulation of electrons that makes use of excited state orbitals (shown as a green outline). of a microwave source (a klystron or a Gunn oscillator), a cavity in which the sample is inserted in a glass or quartz container, a microwave detector, and an electromagnet with a field that can be varied in the region of 0.3 T. The EPR spectrum is obtained by monitoring the microwave absorption as the field is changed, and a typical spectrum (of the benzene radical anion, C6H6 − ) is shown in Fig. 15.55. The peculiar appearance of the spectrum, which is in fact the first-derivative of the absorption, arises from the detection technique, which is sensitive to the slope of the absorption curve (Fig. 15.56). 15.15 The g-value Equation 15.13b gives the resonance frequency for a transition between the ms = −1 –2 and the ms = +1 –2 levels of a ‘free’ electron in terms of the g-value ge ≈ 2.0023. The magnetic moment of an unpaired electron in a radical also interacts with an external field, but the g-value is different from that for a free electron because of local magnetic fields induced by the molecular framework of the radical. Consequently, the resonance condition is normally written as hν = gµBB0 (15.40) where g is the g-value of the radical. Illustration 15.4 Calculating the g-value of an organic radical The centre of the EPR spectrum of the methyl radical occurred at 329.40 mT in a spectrometer operating at 9.2330 GHz (radiation belonging to the X band of the microwave region). Its g-value is therefore g = = = 2.0027 Self-test 15.4 At what magnetic field would the methyl radical come into resonance in a spectrometer operating at 34.000 GHz (radiation belonging to the Q band of the microwave region)? [1.213 T] The g-value in a molecular environment (a radical or a d-metal complex) is related to the ease with which the applied field can stir up currents through the molecular framework and the strength of the magnetic field the currents generate. Therefore, the g-value gives some information about electronic structure and plays a similar role in EPR to that played by shielding constants in NMR. Electrons can migrate through the molecular framework by making use of excited states (Fig. 15.57). This additional path for circulation of electrons gives rise to a local magnetic field that adds to the applied field. Therefore, we expect that the ease of stirring up currents to be inversely proportional to the separation of energy levels, ∆E, in the molecule. As we saw in Section 10.8, the strength of the field generated by electronic currents in atoms (and analogously in molecules) is related to the extent of coupling between spin and orbital angular momenta. That is, the local field strength is proportional to the molecular spin–orbit coupling constant, ξ. We can conclude from the discussion above that the g-value of a radical or d-metal complex differs from ge, the ‘free-electron’ g-value, by an amount that is proportional to ξ/∆E. This proportionality is widely observed. Many organic radicals have g-values close to 2.0027 and inorganic radicals have g-values typically in the range 1.9 to 2.1. The g-values of paramagnetic d-metal complexes often differ considerably from ge, (6.626 08 × 10−34 J s) × (9.2330 × 109 s−1 ) (9.2740 × 10−24 J T−1 ) × (0.329 40 T) hν µBB 15.16 HYPERFINE STRUCTURE 551 varying from 0 to 6, because in them ∆E is small (on account of the splitting of dorbitals brought about by interactions with ligands, as we saw in Section 14.2). Just as in the case of the chemical shift in NMR spectroscopy, the g-value is anisotropic: that is, its magnitude depends on the orientation of the radical with respect to the applied field. In solution, when the molecule is tumbling rapidly, only the average value of the g-value is observed. Therefore, anisotropy of the g-value is observed only for radicals trapped in solids. 15.16 Hyperfine structure The most important feature of EPR spectra is their hyperfine structure, the splitting of individual resonance lines into components. In general in spectroscopy, the term ‘hyperfine structure’ means the structure of a spectrum that can be traced to interactions of the electrons with nuclei other than as a result of the latter’s point electric charge. The source of the hyperfine structure in EPR is the magnetic interaction between the electron spin and the magnetic dipole moments of the nuclei present in the radical. (a) The effects of nuclear spin Consider the effect on the EPR spectrum of a single H nucleus located somewhere in a radical. The proton spin is a source of magnetic field, and depending on the orientation of the nuclear spin, the field it generates adds to or subtracts from the applied field. The total local field is therefore Bloc = B + amI mI = ±1 –2 (15.41) where a is the hyperfine coupling constant. Half the radicals in a sample have mI = +1 –2, so half resonate when the applied field satisfies the condition hν = gµB(B + 1 –2a), or B = − 1 –2a (15.42a) The other half (which have mI = −1 –2) resonate when hν = gµB(B − 1 –2a), or B = + 1 –2a (15.42b) Therefore, instead of a single line, the spectrum shows two lines of half the original intensity separated by a and centred on the field determined by g (Fig. 15.58). If the radical contains an 14 N atom (I = 1), its EPR spectrum consists of three lines of equal intensity, because the 14 N nucleus has three possible spin orientations, and each spin orientation is possessed by one-third of all the radicals in the sample. In general, a spin-I nucleus splits the spectrum into 2I + 1 hyperfine lines of equal intensity. When there are several magnetic nuclei present in the radical, each one contributes to the hyperfine structure. In the case of equivalent protons (for example, the two CH2 protons in the radical CH3CH2) some of the hyperfine lines are coincident. It is not hard to show that, if the radical contains N equivalent protons, then there are N + 1 hyperfine lines with a binomial intensity distribution (the intensity distribution given by Pascal’s triangle). The spectrum of the benzene radical anion in Fig. 15.55, which has seven lines with intensity ratio 1:6:15:20:15:6:1, is consistent with a radical containing six equivalent protons. More generally, if the radical contains N equivalent nuclei with spin quantum number I, then there are 2NI + 1 hyperfine lines with an intensity distribution based on a modified version of Pascal’s triangle as shown in the following Example. hν gµB hν gµB N N N N ha b No hyperfine splitting Hyperfine splitting due to one proton a a b b n Fig. 15.58 The hyperfine interaction between an electron and a spin-1 –2 nucleus results in four energy levels in place of the original two. As a result, the spectrum consists of two lines (of equal intensity) instead of one. The intensity distribution can be summarized by a simple stick diagram. The diagonal lines show the energies of the states as the applied field is increased, and resonance occurs when the separation of states matches the fixed energy of the microwave photon. 552 15 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 3: MAGNETIC RESONANCE 1:2:1 1:2:1 1:2:1 1.61 mT 0.35 mT Fig. 15.59 The analysis of the hyperfine structure of radicals containing one 14 N nucleus (I = 1) and two equivalent protons. 1 3 6 7 6 3 1 Fig. 15.60 The analysis of the hyperfine structure of radicals containing three equivalent 14 N nuclei. Example 15.3 Predicting the hyperfine structure of an EPR spectrum A radical contains one 14 N nucleus (I = 1) with hyperfine constant 1.61 mT and two equivalent protons (I = 1 –2) with hyperfine constant 0.35 mT. Predict the form of the EPR spectrum. Method We should consider the hyperfine structure that arises from each type of nucleus or group of equivalent nuclei in succession. So, split a line with one nucleus, then each of those lines is split by a second nucleus (or group of nuclei), and so on. It is best to start with the nucleus with the largest hyperfine splitting; however, any choice could be made, and the order in which nuclei are considered does not affect the conclusion. Answer The 14 N nucleus gives three hyperfine lines of equal intensity separated by 1.61 mT. Each line is split into doublets of spacing 0.35 mT by the first proton, and each line of these doublets is split into doublets with the same 0.35 mT splitting (Fig. 15.59). The central lines of each split doublet coincide, so the proton splitting gives 1:2:1 triplets of internal splitting 0.35 mT. Therefore, the spectrum consists of three equivalent 1:2:1 triplets. Self-test 15.5 Predict the form of the EPR spectrum of a radical containing three equivalent 14 N nuclei. [Fig. 15.60] The hyperfine structure of an EPR spectrum is a kind of fingerprint that helps to identify the radicals present in a sample. Moreover, because the magnitude of the splitting depends on the distribution of the unpaired electron near the magnetic nuclei present, the spectrum can be used to map the molecular orbital occupied by the unpaired electron. For example, because the hyperfine splitting in C6H6 − is 0.375 mT, and one proton is close to a C atom with one-sixth the unpaired electron spin density (because the electron is spread uniformly around the ring), the hyperfine splitting caused by a proton in the electron spin entirely confined to a single adjacent C atom should be 6 × 0.375 mT = 2.25 mT. If in another aromatic radical we find a hyperfine splitting constant a, then the spindensity, ρ, the probability that an unpaired electron is on the atom, can be calculated from the McConnell equation: a = Qρ (15.43) with Q = 2.25 mT. In this equation, ρ is the spin density on a C atom and a is the hyperfine splitting observed for the H atom to which it is attached. Illustration 15.5 Using the McConnell equation The hyperfine structure of the EPR spectrum of the radical anion (naphthalene)− can be interpreted as arising from two groups of four equivalent protons. Those at the 1, 4, 5, and 8 positions in the ring have a = 0.490 mT and for those in the 2, 3, 6, and 7 positions have a = 0.183 mT. The densities obtained by using the McConnell equation are 0.22 and 0.08, respectively (8). Self-test 15.6 The spin density in (anthracene)− is shown in (9). Predict the form of its EPR spectrum. [A 1:2:1 triplet of splitting 0.43 mT split into a 1:4:6:4:1 quintet of splitting 0.22 mT, split into a 1:4:6:4:1 quintet of plitting 0.11 mT, 3 × 5 × 5 = 75 lines in all] I15.2 IMPACT ON BIOCHEMISTRY: SPIN PROBES 553 (b) The origin of the hyperfine interaction The hyperfine interaction is an interaction between the magnetic moments of the unpaired electron and the nuclei. There are two contributions to the interaction. An electron in a p orbital does not approach the nucleus very closely, so it experiences a field that appears to arise from a point magnetic dipole. The resulting interaction is called the dipole–dipole interaction. The contribution of a magnetic nucleus to the local field experienced by the unpaired electron is given by an expression like that in eqn 15.28. A characteristic of this type of interaction is that it is anisotropic. Furthermore, just as in the case of NMR, the dipole–dipole interaction averages to zero when the radical is free to tumble. Therefore, hyperfine structure due to the dipole–dipole interaction is observed only for radicals trapped in solids. An s electron is spherically distributed around a nucleus and so has zero average dipole–dipole interaction with the nucleus even in a solid sample. However, because an s electron has a nonzero probability of being at the nucleus, it is incorrect to treat the interaction as one between two point dipoles. An s electron has a Fermi contact interaction with the nucleus, which as we saw in Section 15.6d is a magnetic interaction that occurs when the point dipole approximation fails. The contact interaction is isotropic (that is, independent of the radical’s orientation), and consequently is shown even by rapidly tumbling molecules in fluids (provided the spin density has some s character). The dipole–dipole interactions of p electrons and the Fermi contact interaction of s electrons can be quite large. For example, a 2p electron in a nitrogen atom experiences an average field of about 3.4 mT from the 14 N nucleus. A 1s electron in a hydrogen atom experiences a field of about 50 mT as a result of its Fermi contact interaction with the central proton. More values are listed in Table 15.3. The magnitudes of the contact interactions in radicals can be interpreted in terms of the s orbital character of the molecular orbital occupied by the unpaired electron, and the dipole–dipole interaction can be interpreted in terms of the p character. The analysis of hyperfine structure therefore gives information about the composition of the orbital, and especially the hybridization of the atomic orbitals (see Problem 15.11). We still have the source of the hyperfine structure of the C6H6 − anion and other aromatic radical anions to explain. The sample is fluid, and as the radicals are tumbling the hyperfine structure cannot be due to the dipole–dipole interaction. Moreover, the protons lie in the nodal plane of the π orbital occupied by the unpaired electron, so the structure cannot be due to a Fermi contact interaction. The explanation lies in a polarizationmechanismsimilartotheoneresponsibleforspin–spincouplinginNMR. There is a magnetic interaction between a proton and the α electrons (ms = + 1 –2) which results in one of the electrons tending to be found with a greater probability nearby (Fig. 15.61). The electron with opposite spin is therefore more likely to be close to the C atom at the other end of the bond. The unpaired electron on the C atom has a lower energy if it is parallel to that electron (Hund’s rule favours parallel electrons on atoms), so the unpaired electron can detect the spin of the proton indirectly. Calculation using this model leads to a hyperfine interaction in agreement with the observed value of 2.25 mT. IMPACT ON BIOCHEMISTRY I15.2 Spin probes We saw in Sections 15.14 and 15.15 that anisotropy of the g-value and of the nuclear hyperfine interactions can be observed when a radical is immobilized in a solid. Figure 15.62 shows the variation of the lineshape of the EPR spectrum of the di-tertbutyl nitroxide radical (10) with temperature. At 292 K, the radical tumbles freely and isotropic hyperfine coupling to the 14 N nucleus gives rise to three sharp peaks. At 77 K, Synoptic table 15.3* Hyperfine coupling constants for atoms, a/mT Isotropic Anisotropic Nuclide coupling coupling 1 H 50.8 (1s) 2 H 7.8 (1s) 14 N 55.2 (2s) 3.4 (2p) 19 F 1720 (2s) 108.4 (2p) * More values are given in the Data section. Hund FermiPauli C H (b) High energy (a) Low energy Fig. 15.61 The polarization mechanism for the hyperfine interaction in π-electron radicals. The arrangement in (a) is lower in energy than that in (b), so there is an effective coupling between the unpaired electron and the proton. T = 77 K T = 292 K Field strength Fig. 15.62 ESR spectra of the di-tert-butyl nitroxide radical at 292 K (top) and 77 K (bottom). Adapted from J.R. Bolton, in Biological applications of electron spin resonance, H.M. Swartz, J.R. Bolton, and D.C. Borg (ed.), Wiley, New York (1972). 554 15 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 3: MAGNETIC RESONANCE motion of the radical is restricted. Both isotropic and anisotropic hyperfine couplings determine the appearance of the spectrum, which now consists of three broad peaks. A spin probe (or spin label) is a radical that interacts with a biopolymer and with an EPR spectrum that reports on the dynamical properties of the biopolymer. The ideal spin probe is one with a spectrum that broadens significantly as its motion is restricted to a relatively small extent. Nitroxide spin probes have been used to show that the hydrophobic interiors of biological membranes, once thought to be rigid, are in fact very fluid and individual lipid molecules move laterally through the sheet-like structure of the membrane. Just as chemical exchange can broaden proton NMR spectra (Section 15.7), electron exchange between two radicals can broaden EPR spectra. Therefore, the distance between two spin probe molecules may be measured from the linewidths of their EPR spectra. The effect can be used in a number of biochemical studies. For example, the kinetics of association of two polypeptides labelled with the synthetic amino acid 2,2,6,6,-tetramethylpiperidine-1-oxyl-4-amino-4-carboxylic acid (11) may be studied by measuring the change in linewidth of the label with time. Alternatively, the thermodynamics of association may be studied by examining the temperature dependence of the linewidth. Checklist of key ideas 1. The energy of an electron in a magnetic field B0 is Ems = −geγe$B0ms, where γe is the magnetogyric ratio of the electron. The energy of a nucleus in a magnetic field B0 is EmI = −γ $B0mI, where γ is the nuclear magnetogyric ratio. 2. The resonance condition for an electron in a magnetic field is hν = geµBB0. The resonance condition for a nucleus in a magnetic field is hν = γ $B0. 3. Nuclear magnetic resonance (NMR) is the observation of the frequency at which magnetic nuclei in molecules come into resonance with an electromagnetic field when the molecule is exposed to a strong magnetic field; NMR is a radiofrequency technique. 4. Electron paramagnetic resonance (EPR) is the observation of the frequency at which an electron spin comes into resonance with an electromagnetic field when the molecule is exposed to a strong magnetic field; EPR is a microwave technique. 5. The intensity of an NMR or EPR transition increases with the difference in population of α and β states and the strength of the applied magnetic field (as B0 2 ). 6. The chemical shift of a nucleus is the difference between its resonance frequency and that of a reference standard; chemical shifts are reported on the δ scale, in which δ = (ν −ν°) × 106 /ν°. 7. The observed shielding constant is the sum of a local contribution, a neighbouring group contribution, and a solvent contribution. 8. The fine structure of an NMR spectrum is the splitting of the groups of resonances into individual lines; the strength of the interaction is expressed in terms of the spin–spin coupling constant, J. 9. N equivalent spin-1 –2 nuclei split the resonance of a nearby spin or group of equivalent spins into N + 1 lines with an intensity distribution given by Pascal’s triangle. 10. Spin–spin coupling in molecules in solution can be explained in terms of the polarization mechanism, in which the interaction is transmitted through the bonds. 11. The Fermi contact interaction is a magnetic interaction that depends on the very close approach of an electron to the nucleus and can occur only if the electron occupies an s orbital. 12. Coalescence of the two lines occurs in conformational interchange or chemical exchange when the lifetime, τ, of the states is related to their resonance frequency difference, δν, by τ = 21/2 /πδν. 13. In Fourier-transform NMR, the spectrum is obtained by mathematical analysis of the free-induction decay of magnetization, the response of nuclear spins in a sample to the application of one or more pulses of radiofrequency radiation. 14. Spin relaxation is the nonradiative return of a spin system to an equilibrium distribution of populations in which the transverse spin orientations are random; the system returns exponentially to the equilibrium population distribution with a time constant called the spin–lattice relaxation time, T1. 15. The spin–spin relaxation time, T2, is the time constant for the exponential return of the system to random transverse spin orientations. 16. In proton decoupling of 13 C-NMR spectra, protons are made to undergo rapid spin reorientations and the 13 C nucleus FURTHER INFORMATION 555 senses an average orientation. As a result, its resonance is a single line and not a group of lines. 17. The nuclear Overhauser effect (NOE) is the modification of one resonance by the saturation of another. 18. In two-dimensional NMR, spectra are displayed in two axes, with resonances belonging to different groups lying at different locations on the second axis. An example of a twodimensional NMR technique is correlation spectroscopy (COSY), in which all spin–spin couplings in a molecule are determined. Another example is nuclear Overhauser effect spectroscopy (NOESY), in which internuclear distances up to about 0.5 nm are determined. 19. Magic-angle spinning (MAS) is technique in which the NMR linewidths in a solid sample are reduced by spinning at an angle of 54.74° to the applied magnetic field. 20. The EPR resonance condition is written hν = gµBB, where g is the g-value of the radical; the deviation of g from ge = 2.0023 depends on the ability of the applied field to induce local electron currents in the radical. 21. The hyperfine structure of an EPR spectrum is its splitting of individual resonance lines into components by the magnetic interaction between the electron and nuclei with spin. 22. If a radical contains N equivalent nuclei with spin quantum number I, then there are 2NI + 1 hyperfine lines with an intensity distribution given by a modified version of Pascal’s triangle. 23. The hyperfine structure due to a hydrogen attached to an aromatic ring is converted to spin density, ρ, on the neighbouring carbon atom by using the McConnell equation: a = Qρ with Q = 2.25 mT. Further reading Articles and texts N.M. Atherton, Principles of electron spin resonance. Ellis Horwood/Prentice Hall, Hemel Hempstead (1993). E.D. Becker, High resolution NMR: theory and chemical applications. Academic Press, San Diego (2000). R. Freeman, Spin choreography: basic steps in high resolution NMR. Oxford University Press (1998). J.C. Lindon, G.E. Tranter, and J.L. Holmes (ed.), Encyclopedia of spectroscopy and spectrometry. Academic Press, San Diego (2000). R.W. King and K.R. Williams. The Fourier transform in chemistry. Part 1. Nuclear magnetic resonance: Introduction. J. Chem. Educ. 66, A213 (1989); Part 2. Nuclear magnetic resonance: The single pulse experiment. Ibid. A243; Part 3. Multiple-pulse experiments. J. Chem. Educ. 67, A93 (1990); Part 4. NMR: Two-dimensional methods. Ibid. A125; A glossary of NMR terms. Ibid. A100. M.T. Vlaardingerbroek and J.A. de Boer, Magnetic resonance imaging: theory and practice. Springer, Berlin (1999). M.H. Levitt, Spin dynamics. Wiley (2001). Sources of data and information D.R. Lide (ed.), CRC Handbook of Chemistry and Physics, Section 9, CRC Press, Boca Raton (2000). C.P. Poole, Jr. and H.A. Farach (ed.), Handbook of electron spin resonance: data sources, computer technology, relaxation, and ENDOR. Vols. 1–2. Springer, Berlin (1997, 1999). Further information Further information 15.1 Fourier transformation of the FID curve The analysis of the FID curve is achieved by the standard mathematical technique of Fourier transformation, which we explored in the context of FT infrared spectroscopy (Further information 13.2). We start by noting that the signal S(t) in the time domain, the total FID curve, is the sum (more precisely, the integral) over all the contributing frequencies S(t) = Ύ ∞ −∞ I(ν)e−2πiνt dν (15.44) Because e2πiνt = cos(2πνt) + i sin(2πνt), the expression above is a sum over harmonically oscillating functions, with each one weighted by the intensity I(ν). We need I(ν), the spectrum in the frequency domain; it is obtained by evaluating the integral I(ν) = 2 Re Ύ ∞ 0 S(t)e2πiνt dt (15.45) where Re means take the real part of the following expression. This integral is very much like an overlap integral: it gives a nonzero value if S(t) contains a component that matches the oscillating function e2iπνt . The integration is carried out at a series of frequencies ν on a computer that is built into the spectrometer. 556 15 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 3: MAGNETIC RESONANCE Discussion questions 15.1 Discuss in detail the origins of the local, neighbouring group, and solvent contributions to the shielding constant. 15.2 Discuss in detail the effects of a 90° pulse and of a 180° pulse on a system of spin-1 –2 nuclei in a static magnetic field. 15.3 Suggest a reason why the relaxation times of 13 C nuclei are typically much longer than those of 1 H nuclei. 15.4 Discuss the origins of diagonal and cross peaks in the COSY spectrum of an AX system. 15.5 Discuss how the Fermi contact interaction and the polarization mechanism contribute to spin–spin couplings in NMR and hyperfine interactions in EPR. 15.6 Suggest how spin probes could be used to estimate the depth of a crevice in a biopolymer, such as the active site of an enzyme. Exercises 15.1a What is the resonance frequency of a proton in a magnetic field of 14.1 T? 15.1b What is the resonance frequency of a 19 F nucleus in a magnetic field of 16.2 T? 15.2a 33 S has a nuclear spin of 3 –2 and a nuclear g-factor of 0.4289. Calculate the energies of the nuclear spin states in a magnetic field of 7.500 T. 15.2b 14 N has a nuclear spin of 1 and a nuclear g-factor of 0.404. Calculate the energies of the nuclear spin states in a magnetic field of 11.50 T. 15.3a Calculate the frequency separation of the nuclear spin levels of a 13 C nucleus in a magnetic field of 14.4 T given that the magnetogyric ratio is 6.73 × 107 T−1 s−1 . 15.3b Calculate the frequency separation of the nuclear spin levels of a 14 N nucleus in a magnetic field of 15.4 T given that the magnetogyric ratio is 1.93 × 107 T−1 s−1 . 15.4a In which of the following systems is the energy level separation the largest? (a) A proton in a 600 MHz NMR spectrometer, (b) a deuteron in the same spectrometer. 15.4b In which of the following systems is the energy level separation the largest? (a) A 14 N nucleus in (for protons) a 600 MHz NMR spectrometer, (b) an electron in a radical in a field of 0.300 T. 15.5a Calculate the energy difference between the lowest and highest nuclear spin states of a 14 N nucleus in a 15.00 T magnetic field. 15.5b Calculate the magnetic field needed to satisfy the resonance condition for unshielded protons in a 150.0 MHz radiofrequency field. 15.6a Use Table 15.2 to predict the magnetic fields at which (a) 1 H, (b) 2 H, (c) 13 C come into resonance at (i) 250 MHz, (ii) 500 MHz. 15.6b Use Table 15.2 to predict the magnetic fields at which (a) 14 N, (b) 19 F, and (c) 31 P come into resonance at (i) 300 MHz, (ii) 750 MHz. 15.7a Calculate the relative population differences (δN/N) for protons in fields of (a) 0.30 T, (b) 1.5 T, and (c) 10 T at 25°C. 15.7b Calculate the relative population differences (δN/N) for 13 C nuclei in fields of (a) 0.50 T, (b) 2.5 T, and (c) 15.5 T at 25°C. 15.8a The first generally available NMR spectrometers operated at a frequency of 60 MHz; today it is not uncommon to use a spectrometer that operates at 800 MHz. What are the relative population differences of 13 C spin states in these two spectrometers at 25°C? 15.8b What are the relative values of the chemical shifts observed for nuclei in the spectrometers mentioned in Exercise 15.8a in terms of (a) δ values, (b) frequencies? 15.9a The chemical shift of the CH3 protons in acetaldehyde (ethanal) is δ = 2.20 and that of the CHO proton is 9.80. What is the difference in local magnetic field between the two regions of the molecule when the applied field is (a) 1.5 T, (b) 15 T? 15.9b The chemical shift of the CH3 protons in diethyl ether is δ = 1.16 and that of the CH2 protons is 3.36. What is the difference in local magnetic field between the two regions of the molecule when the applied field is (a) 1.9 T, (b) 16.5 T? 15.10a Sketch the appearance of the 1 H-NMR spectrum of acetaldehyde (ethanal) using J = 2.90 Hz and the data in Exercise 15.9a in a spectrometer operating at (a) 250 MHz, (b) 500 MHz. 15.10b Sketch the appearance of the 1 H-NMR spectrum of diethyl ether using J = 6.97 Hz and the data in Exercise 15.9b in a spectrometer operating at (a) 350 MHz, (b) 650 MHz. 15.11a Two groups of protons are made equivalent by the isomerization of a fluxional molecule. At low temperatures, where the interconversion is slow, one group has δ = 4.0 and the other has δ = 5.2. At what rate of interconversion will the two signals merge in a spectrometer operating at 250 MHz? 15.11b Two groups of protons are made equivalent by the isomerization of a fluxional molecule. At low temperatures, where the interconversion is slow, one group has δ = 5.5 and the other has δ = 6.8. At what rate of interconversion will the two signals merge in a spectrometer operating at 350 MHz? 15.12a Sketch the form of the 19 F-NMR spectra of a natural sample of tetrafluoroborate ions, BF− 4, allowing for the relative abundances of 10 BF4 − and 11 BF4 − . 15.12b From the data in Table 15.2, predict the frequency needed for 31 PNMR in an NMR spectrometer designed to observe proton resonance at 500 MHz. Sketch the proton and 31 P resonances in the NMR spectrum of PH4 + . 15.13a Sketch the form of an A3M2X4 spectrum, where A, M, and X are protons with distinctly different chemical shifts and JAM > JAX > JMX. 15.13b Sketch the form of an A2M2X5 spectrum, where A, M, and X are protons with distinctly different chemical shifts and JAM > JAX > JMX. 15.14a Which of the following molecules have sets of nuclei that are chemically but not magnetically equivalent? (a) CH3CH3, (b) CH2=CH2. PROBLEMS 557 15.14b Which of the following molecules have sets of nuclei that are chemically but not magnetically equivalent? (a) CH2=C=CF2, (b) cis- and trans-[Mo(CO)4(PH3)2]. 15.15a The duration of a 90° or 180° pulse depends on the strength of the B1 field. If a 90° pulse requires 10 µs, what is the strength of the B1 field? How long would the corresponding 180° pulse require? 15.15b The duration of a 90° or 180° pulse depends on the strength of the B1 field. If a 180° pulse requires 12.5 µs, what is the strength of the B1 field? How long would the corresponding 90° pulse require? 15.16a What magnetic field would be required in order to use an EPR X–band spectrometer (9 GHz) to observe 1 H-NMR and a 300 MHz spectrometer to observe EPR? 15.16b Some commercial EPR spectrometers use 8 mm microwave radiation (the Q band). What magnetic field is needed to satisfy the resonance condition? 15.17a The centre of the EPR spectrum of atomic hydrogen lies at 329.12 mT in a spectrometer operating at 9.2231 GHz. What is the g-value of the electron in the atom? 15.17b The centre of the EPR spectrum of atomic deuterium lies at 330.02 mT in a spectrometer operating at 9.2482 GHz. What is the g-value of the electron in the atom? 15.18a A radical containing two equivalent protons shows a three-line spectrum with an intensity distribution 1:2:1. The lines occur at 330.2 mT, 332.5 mT, and 334.8 mT. What is the hyperfine coupling constant for each proton? What is the g-value of the radical given that the spectrometer is operating at 9.319 GHz? 15.18b A radical containing three equivalent protons shows a four–line spectrum with an intensity distribution 1:3:3:1. The lines occur at 331.4 mT, 333.6 mT, 335.8 mT, and 338.0 mT. What is the hyperfine coupling constant for each proton? What is the g-value of the radical given that the spectrometer is operating at 9.332 GHz? 15.19a A radical containing two inequivalent protons with hyperfine constants 2.0 mT and 2.6 mT gives a spectrum centred on 332.5 mT. At what fields do the hyperfine lines occur and what are their relative intensities? 15.19b A radical containing three inequivalent protons with hyperfine constants 2.11 mT, 2.87 mT, and 2.89 mT gives a spectrum centred on 332.8 mT. At what fields do the hyperfine lines occur and what are their relative intensities? 15.20a Predict the intensity distribution in the hyperfine lines of the EPR spectra of (a) ·CH3, (b) ·CD3. 15.20b Predict the intensity distribution in the hyperfine lines of the EPR spectra of (a) ·CH2H3, (b) ·CD2CD3. 15.21a The benzene radical anion has g = 2.0025. At what field should you search for resonance in a spectrometer operating at (a) 9.302 GHz, (b) 33.67 GHz? 15.21b The naphthalene radical anion has g = 2.0024. At what field should you search for resonance in a spectrometer operating at (a) 9.312 GHz, (b) 33.88 GHz? 15.22a The EPR spectrum of a radical with a single magnetic nucleus is split into four lines of equal intensity. What is the nuclear spin of the nucleus? 15.22b The EPR spectrum of a radical with two equivalent nuclei of a particular kind is split into five lines of intensity ratio 1:2:3:2:1. What is the spin of the nuclei? 15.23a Sketch the form of the hyperfine structures of radicals XH2 and XD2, where the nucleus X has I = 5 –2. 15.23b Sketch the form of the hyperfine structures of radicals XH3 and XD3, where the nucleus X has I = 3 –2. Problems* Numerical problems 15.1 A scientist investigates the possibility of neutron spin resonance, and has available a commercial NMR spectrometer operating at 300 MHz. What field is required for resonance? What is the relative population difference at room temperature? Which is the lower energy spin state of the neutron? 15.2 Two groups of protons have δ = 4.0 and δ = 5.2 and are interconverted by a conformational change of a fluxional molecule. In a 60 MHz spectrometer the spectrum collapsed into a single line at 280 K but at 300 MHz the collapse did not occur until the temperature had been raised to 300 K. What is the activation energy of the interconversion? 15.3‡ Suppose that the FID in Fig. 15.31 was recorded in a 300 MHz spectrometer, and that the interval between maxima in the oscillations in the FID is 0.10 s. What is the Larmor frequency of the nuclei and the spin–spin relaxation time? 15.4‡ In a classic study of the application of NMR to the measurement of rotational barriers in molecules, P.M. Nair and J.D. Roberts (J. Am. Chem. Soc. 79, 4565 (1957)) obtained the 40 MHz 19 F-NMR spectrum of F2BrCCBrCl2. Their spectra are reproduced in Fig. 15.63. At 193 K the spectrum shows five resonance peaks. Peaks I and III are separated by 160 Hz, as are IV and V. The ratio of the integrated intensities of peak II to peaks I, III, IV, and V is approximately 10 to 1. At 273 K, the five peaks have collapsed into * Problems denoted with the symbol ‡ were supplied by Charles Trapp and Carmen Giunta. Fig. 15.63 0°C -30°C -60°C -80°C I II III IV V 160 Hz 558 15 MOLECULAR SPECTROSCOPY 3: MAGNETIC RESONANCE four equivalent protons. Predict the form of the EPR spectrum using a(N) = 0.148 mT and a(H) = 0.112 mT. 15.11 When an electron occupies a 2s orbital on an N atom it has a hyperfine interaction of 55.2 mT with the nucleus. The spectrum of NO2 shows an isotropic hyperfine interaction of 5.7 mT. For what proportion of its time is the unpaired electron of NO2 occupying a 2s orbital? The hyperfine coupling constant for an electron in a 2p orbital of an N atom is 3.4 mT. In NO2 the anisotropic part of the hyperfine coupling is 1.3 mT. What proportion of its time does the unpaired electron spend in the 2p orbital of the N atom in NO2? What is the total probability that the electron will be found on (a) the N atoms, (b) the O atoms? What is the hybridization ratio of the N atom? Does the hybridization support the view that NO2 is angular? 15.12 The hyperfine coupling constants observed in the radical anions (12), (13), and (14) are shown (in millitesla, mT). Use the value for the benzene radical anion to map the probability of finding the unpaired electron in the π orbital on each C atom. 12345 2 3 5 NO CH CH CH2 2 2 3 1 4 d d one. Explain the spectrum and its change with temperature. At what rate of interconversion will the spectrum collapse to a single line? Calculate the rotational energy barrier between the rotational isomers on the assumption that it is related to the rate of interconversion between the isomers. 15.5‡ Various versions of the Karplus equation (eqn 15.27) have been used to correlate data on vicinal proton coupling constants in systems of the type R1R2CHCHR3R4. The original version, (M. Karplus, J. Am. Chem. Soc. 85, 2870 (1963)), is 3 JHH = A cos2 φHH + B. When R3 = R4 = H, 3 JHH = 7.3 Hz; when R3 = CH3 and R4 = H, 3 JHH = 8.0 Hz; when R3 = R4 = CH3, 3 JHH = 11.2 Hz. Assume that only staggered conformations are important and determine which version of the Karplus equation fits the data better. 15.6‡ It might be unexpected that the Karplus equation, which was first derived for 3 JHH coupling constants, should also apply to vicinal coupling between the nuclei of metals such as tin. T.N. Mitchell and B. Kowall (Magn. Reson. Chem. 33, 325 (1995)) have studied the relation between 3 JHH and 3 JSnSn in compounds of the type Me3SnCH2CHRSnMe3 and find that 3 JSnSn = 78.863 JHH + 27.84 Hz. (a) Does this result support a Karplus type equation for tin? Explain your reasoning. (b) Obtain the Karplus equation for 3 JSnSn and plot it as a function of the dihedral angle. (c) Draw the preferred conformation. 15.7 Figure 15.64 shows the proton COSY spectrum of 1-nitropropane. Account for the appearance of off-diagonal peaks in the spectrum. Theoretical problems 15.13 Calculate σd for a hydrogenic atom with atomic number Z. 15.14 In this problem you will use the molecular electronic structure methods described in Chapter 11 to investigate the hypothesis that the magnitude of the 13 C chemical shift correlates with the net charge on a13 C atom. (a) Using molecular modelling software3 and the computational method of your choice, calculate the net charge at the C atom para to the substituents in this series of molecules: benzene, phenol, toluene, trifluorotoluene, benzonitrile, and nitrobenzene. (b) The 13 C chemical shifts of the para C atoms in each of the molecules that you examined in part (a) are given below: Substituent OH CH3 H CF3 CN NO2 δ 130.1 128.4 128.5 128.9 129.1 129.4 Is there a linear correlation between net charge and 13 C chemical shift of the para C atom in this series of molecules? (c) If you did find a correlation in part (b), use the concepts developed in this chapter to explain the physical origins of the correlation. 3 Thewebsitecontainslinkstomolecularmodellingfreewareandtoothersiteswhereyoumayperformmolecularorbitalcalculationsdirectlyfromyourwebbrowser. Fig. 15.64 The COSY spectrum of 1-nitropropane (NO2CH2CH2CH3). The circles show enhanced views of the spectral features. (Spectrum provided by Prof. G. Morris.) 15.8 The angular NO2 molecule has a single unpaired electron and can be trapped in a solid matrix or prepared inside a nitrite crystal by radiation damage of NO2 − ions. When the applied field is parallel to the OO direction the centre of the spectrum lies at 333.64 mT in a spectrometer operating at 9.302 GHz. When the field lies along the bisector of the ONO angle, the resonance lies at 331.94 mT. What are the g-values in the two orientations? 15.9 The hyperfine coupling constant in ·CH3 is 2.3 mT. Use the information in Table 15.3 to predict the splitting between the hyperfine lines of the spectrum of ·CD3. What are the overall widths of the hyperfine spectra in each case? 15.10 The p-dinitrobenzene radical anion can be prepared by reduction of p-dinitrobenzene. The radical anion has two equivalent N nuclei (I = 1) and PROBLEMS 559 15.15 The z-component of the magnetic field at a distance R from a magnetic moment parallel to the z-axis is given by eqn 15.28. In a solid, a proton at a distance R from another can experience such a field and the measurement of the splitting it causes in the spectrum can be used to calculate R. In gypsum, for instance, the splitting in the H2O resonance can be interpreted in terms of a magnetic field of 0.715 mT generated by one proton and experienced by the other. What is the separation of the protons in the H2O molecule? 15.16 In a liquid, the dipolar magnetic field averages to zero: show this result by evaluating the average of the field given in eqn 15.28. Hint. The volume element is sin θ dθdφ in polar coordinates. 15.17 The shape of a spectral line, I(ω), is related to the free induction decay signal G(t) by I(ω) = a Re Ύ ∞ 0 G(t)eiωt dt where a is a constant and ‘Re’ means take the real part of what follows. Calculate the lineshape corresponding to an oscillating, decaying function G(t) = cos ω0t e−t/τ . 15.18 In the language of Problem 15.17, show that, if G(t) = (a cos ω1t + b cos ω2t)e−t/τ , then the spectrum consists of two lines with intensities proportional to a and b and located at ω = ω1 and ω2, respectively. 15.19 EPR spectra are commonly discussed in terms of the parameters that occur in the spin-hamiltonian, a hamiltonian operator that incorporates various effects involving spatial operators (like the orbital angular momentum) into operators that depend on the spin alone. Show that, if you use H = −geγeB0sz − γeB0lz as the true hamiltonian, then from second-order perturbation theory (and specifically eqn 9.65), the eigenvalues of the spin are the same as those of the spin-hamiltonian Hspin = −gγeB0sz (note the g in place of ge) and find an expression for g. Applications: to biochemistry and medicine 15.20 Interpret the following features of the NMR spectra of hen lysozyme: (a) saturation of a proton resonance assigned to the side chain of methionine- 105 changes the intensities of proton resonances assigned to the side chains of tryptophan-28 and tyrosine-23; (b) saturation of proton resonances assigned to tryptophan-28 did not affect the spectrum of tyrosine-23. 15.21 When interacting with a large biopolymer or even larger organelle, a small molecule might not rotate freely in all directions and the dipolar interaction might not average to zero. Suppose a molecule is bound so that, although the vector separating two protons may rotate freely around the zaxis, the colatitude may vary only between 0 and θ′. Average the dipolar field over this restricted range of orientations and confirm that the average vanishes when θ′ = π (corresponding to rotation over an entire sphere). What is the average value of the local dipolar field for the H2O molecule in Problem 15.15 if it is bound to a biopolymer that enables it to rotate up to θ′ = 30°? 15.22 Suggest a reason why the spin–lattice relaxation time of benzene (a small molecule) in a mobile, deuterated hydrocarbon solvent increases with temperature whereas that of an oligonucleotide (a large molecule) decreases. 15.23 NMR spectroscopy may be used to determine the equilibrium constant for dissociation of a complex between a small molecule, such as an enzyme inhibitor I, and a protein, such as an enzyme E: EI 5 E + I KI = [E][I]/[EI] In the limit of slow chemical exchange, the NMR spectrum of a proton in I would consist of two resonances: one at νI for free I and another at νEI for bound I. When chemical exchange is fast, the NMR spectrum of the same proton in I consists of a single peak with a resonance frequency ν given by ν = fIνI + fEIνEI, where fI = [I]/([I] + [EI]) and fEI = [EI]/([I] + [EI]) are, respectively, the fractions of free I and bound I. For the purposes of analysing the data, it is also useful to define the frequency differences δν = ν − νI and ∆ν = νEI − νI. Show that, when the initial concentration of I, [I]0, is much greater than the initial concentration of E, [E]0, a plot of [I]0 against δν−1 is a straight line with slope [E]0∆ν and y-intercept −KI. 15.24 The molecular electronic structure methods described in Chapter 11 may be used to predict the spin density distribution in a radical. Recent EPR studies have shown that the amino acid tyrosine participates in a number of biological electron transfer reactions, including the processes of water oxidation to O2 in plant photosystem II and of O2 reduction to water in cytochrome c oxidase (Impact I17.2). During the course of these electron transfer reactions, a tyrosine radical forms, with spin density delocalized over the side chain of the amino acid. (a) The phenoxy radical shown in (15) is a suitable model of the tyrosine radical. Using molecular modelling software and the computational method of your choice (semi-empirical or ab initio methods), calculate the spin densities at the O atom and at all of the C atoms in (15). (b) Predict the form of the EPR spectrum of (15). 15.25 Sketch the EPR spectra of the di-tert-butyl nitroxide radical (10) at 292 K in the limits of very low concentration (at which electron exchange is negligible), moderate concentration (at which electron exchange effects begin to be observed), and high concentration (at which electron exchange effects predominate). Discuss how the observation of electron exchange between nitroxide spin probes can inform the study of lateral mobility of lipids in a biological membrane. 15.26 You are designing an MRI spectrometer. What field gradient (in microtesla per metre, µT m−1 ) is required to produce a separation of 100 Hz between two protons separated by the long diameter of a human kidney (taken as 8 cm) given that they are in environments with δ = 3.4? The radiofrequency field of the spectrometer is at 400 MHz and the applied field is 9.4 T. 15.27 Suppose a uniform disk-shaped organ is in a linear field gradient, and that the MRI signal is proportional to the number of protons in a slice of width δx at each horizontal distance x from the centre of the disk. Sketch the shape of the absorption intensity for the MRI image of the disk before any computer manipulation has been carried out. Statistical thermodynamics 1: the concepts Statistical thermodynamics provides the link between the microscopic properties of matter and its bulk properties. Two key ideas are introduced in this chapter. The first is the Boltzmann distribution, which is used to predict the populations of states in systems at thermal equilibrium. In this chapter we see its derivation in terms of the distribution of particles over available states. The derivation leads naturally to the introduction of the partition function, which is the central mathematical concept of this and the next chapter. We see how to interpret the partition function and how to calculate it in a number of simple cases. We then see how to extract thermodynamic information from the partition function. In the final part of the chapter, we generalize the discussion to include systems that are composed of assemblies of interacting particles. Very similar equations are developed to those in the first part of the chapter, but they are much more widely applicable. The preceding chapters of this part of the text have shown how the energy levels of molecules can be calculated, determined spectroscopically, and related to their structures. The next major step is to see how a knowledge of these energy levels can be used to account for the properties of matter in bulk. To do so, we now introduce the concepts of statistical thermodynamics, the link between individual molecular properties and bulk thermodynamic properties. The crucial step in going from the quantum mechanics of individual molecules to the thermodynamics of bulk samples is to recognize that the latter deals with the average behaviour of large numbers of molecules. For example, the pressure of a gas depends on the average force exerted by its molecules, and there is no need to specify which molecules happen to be striking the wall at any instant. Nor is it necessary to consider the fluctuations in the pressure as different numbers of molecules collide with the wall at different moments. The fluctuations in pressure are very small compared with the steady pressure: it is highly improbable that there will be a sudden lull in the number of collisions, or a sudden surge. Fluctuations in other thermodynamic properties also occur, but for large numbers of particles they are negligible compared to the mean values. This chapter introduces statistical thermodynamics in two stages. The first, the derivation of the Boltzmann distribution for individual particles, is of restricted applicability, but it has the advantage of taking us directly to a result of central importance in a straightforward and elementary way. We can use statistical thermodynamics once we have deduced the Boltzmann distribution. Then (in Section 16.5) we extend the arguments to systems composed of interacting particles. The distribution of molecular states 16.1 Configurations and weights 16.2 The molecular partition function I16.1 Impact on biochemistry: The helix–coil transition in polypeptides The internal energy and the entropy 16.3 The internal energy 16.4 The statistical entropy The canonical partition function 16.5 The canonical ensemble 16.6 The thermodynamic information in the partition function 16.7 Independent molecules Checklist of key ideas Further reading Further information 16.1: The Boltzmann distribution Further information 16.2: The Boltzmann formula Further information 16.3: Temperatures below zero Discussion questions Exercises Problems 16 16.1 CONFIGURATIONS AND WEIGHTS 561 The distribution of molecular states We consider a closed system composed of N molecules. Although the total energy is constant at E, it is not possible to be definite about how that energy is shared between the molecules. Collisions result in the ceaseless redistribution of energy not only between the molecules but also among their different modes of motion. The closest we can come to a description of the distribution of energy is to report the population of a state, the average number of molecules that occupy it, and to say that on average there are ni molecules in a state of energy εi. The populations of the states remain almost constant, but the precise identities of the molecules in each state may change at every collision. The problem we address in this section is the calculation of the populations of states for any type of molecule in any mode of motion at any temperature. The only restriction is that the molecules should be independent, in the sense that the total energy of the system is a sum of their individual energies. We are discounting (at this stage) the possibility that in a real system a contribution to the total energy may arise from interactions between molecules. We also adopt the principle of equal a priori probabilities, the assumption that all possibilities for the distribution of energy are equally probable. A priori means in this context loosely ‘as far as one knows’. We have no reason to presume otherwise than that, for a collection of molecules at thermal equilibrium, vibrational states of a certain energy, for instance, are as likely to be populated as rotational states of the same energy. One very important conclusion that will emerge from the following analysis is that thepopulationsofstatesdependonasingleparameter,the‘temperature’.Thatis,statistical thermodynamics provides a molecular justification for the concept of temperature and some insight into this crucially important quantity. 16.1 Configurations and weights Any individual molecule may exist in states with energies ε0, ε1, . . . . We shall always take ε0, the lowest state, as the zero of energy (ε0 = 0), and measure all other energies relative to that state. To obtain the actual internal energy, U, we may have to add a constant to the calculated energy of the system. For example, if we are considering the vibrational contribution to the internal energy, then we must add the total zero-point energy of any oscillators in the sample. (a) Instantaneous configurations At any instant there will be n0 molecules in the state with energy ε0, n1 with ε1, and so on. The specification of the set of populations n0, n1, . . . in the form {n0, n1, . . . } is a statement of the instantaneous configuration of the system. The instantaneous configuration fluctuates with time because the populations change. We can picture a large number of different instantaneous configurations. One, for example, might be {N,0,0, . . . }, corresponding to every molecule being in its ground state. Another might be {N − 2,2,0,0, . . . }, in which two molecules are in the first excited state. The latter configuration is intrinsically more likely to be found than the former because it can be achieved in more ways: {N,0,0, . . . } can be achieved in only one way, but {N − 2,2,0, . . . } can be achieved in 1 –2N(N − 1) different ways (Fig. 16.1; see Justification 16.1). At this stage in the argument, we are ignoring the requirement that the total energy of the system should be constant (the second configuration has a higher energy than the first). The constraint of total energy is imposed later in this section. Fig. 16.1 Whereas a configuration {5,0,0, . . . } can be achieved in only one way, a configuration {3,2,0, . . . } can be achieved in the ten different ways shown here, where the tinted blocks represent different molecules. 562 16 STATISTICAL THERMODYNAMICS 1: THE CONCEPTS Comment 16.1 More formally, W is called the multinomial coefficient (see Appendix 2). In eqn 16.1, x!, x factorial, denotes x(x − 1)(x − 2) . . . 1, and by definition 0! = 1. 3! 6! 5! 4! N = 18Fig. 16.2 The 18 molecules shown here can be distributed into four receptacles (distinguished by the three vertical lines) in 18! different ways. However, 3! of the selections that put three molecules in the first receptacle are equivalent, 6! that put six molecules into the second receptacle are equivalent, and so on. Hence the number of distinguishable arrangements is 18!/3!6!5!4!. If, as a result of collisions, the system were to fluctuate between the configurations {N,0,0, . . . } and {N − 2,2,0, . . . }, it would almost always be found in the second, more likely state (especially if N were large). In other words, a system free to switch between the two configurations would show properties characteristic almost exclusively of the second configuration. A general configuration {n0,n1, . . . } can be achieved in W different ways, where W is called the weight of the configuration. The weight of the configuration {n0,n1, . . . } is given by the expression W = (16.1) Equation 16.1 is a generalization of the formula W = 1 –2N(N − 1), and reduces to it for the configuration {N − 2,2,0, . . . }. Justification 16.1 The weight of a configuration First, consider the weight of the configuration {N − 2,2,0,0, . . . }. One candidate for promotion to an upper state can be selected in N ways. There are N − 1 candidates for the second choice, so the total number of choices is N(N − 1). However, we should not distinguish the choice (Jack, Jill) from the choice (Jill, Jack) because they lead to the same configurations. Therefore, only half the choices lead to distinguishable configurations, and the total number of distinguishable choices is 1–2N(N − 1). Now we generalize this remark. Consider the number of ways of distributing N balls into bins. The first ball can be selected in N different ways, the next ball in N − 1 different ways for the balls remaining, and so on. Therefore, there are N(N − 1) . . . 1 = N! ways of selecting the balls for distribution over the bins. However, if there are n0 balls in the bin labelled ε0, there would be n0! different ways in which the same balls could have been chosen (Fig. 16.2). Similarly, there are n1! ways in which the n1 balls in the bin labelled ε1 can be chosen, and so on. Therefore, the total number of distinguishable ways of distributing the balls so that there are n0 in bin ε0, n1 in bin ε1, etc. regardless of the order in which the balls were chosen is N!/n0!n1! . . . , which is the content of eqn 16.1. Illustration 16.1 Calculating the weight of a distribution To calculate the number of ways of distributing 20 identical objects with the arrangement 1, 0, 3, 5, 10, 1, we note that the configuration is {1,0,3,5,10,1} with N = 20; therefore the weight is W = = 9.31 × 108 Self-test 16.1 Calculate the weight of the configuration in which 20 objects are distributed in the arrangement 0, 1, 5, 0, 8, 0, 3, 2, 0, 1. [4.19 × 1010 ] 20! 1!0!3!5!10!1! N! n0!n1!n2! . . . 16.1 CONFIGURATIONS AND WEIGHTS 563 It will turn out to be more convenient to deal with the natural logarithm of the weight, ln W, rather than with the weight itself. We shall therefore need the expression ln W = ln = ln N! − ln(n0!n1!n2! · · · ) = ln N! − (ln n0! + ln n1! + ln n2! + · · · ) = ln N! − ∑ i ln ni! where in the first line we have used ln(x/y) = ln x − ln y and in the second ln xy = ln x + ln y. One reason for introducing ln W is that it is easier to make approximations. In particular, we can simplify the factorials by using Stirling’sapproximation in the form ln x! ≈ x ln x − x (16.2) Then the approximate expression for the weight is ln W = (N ln N − N) − ∑ i (ni ln ni − ni) = N ln N − ∑ i ni ln ni (16.3) The final form of eqn 16.3 is derived by noting that the sum of ni is equal to N, so the second and fourth terms in the second expression cancel. (b) The Boltzmann distribution We have seen that the configuration {N − 2,2,0, . . . } dominates {N,0,0, . . . }, and it should be easy to believe that there may be other configurations that have a much greater weight than both. We shall see, in fact, that there is a configuration with so great a weight that it overwhelms all the rest in importance to such an extent that the system will almost always be found in it. The properties of the system will therefore be characteristic of that particular dominating configuration. This dominating configuration can be found by looking for the values of ni that lead to a maximum value of W. Because W is a function of all the ni, we can do this search by varying the ni and looking for the values that correspond to dW = 0 (just as in the search for the maximum of any function), or equivalently a maximum value of ln W. However, there are two difficulties with this procedure. The first difficulty is that the only permitted configurations are those corresponding to the specified, constant, total energy of the system. This requirement rules out many configurations; {N,0,0, . . . } and {N − 2,2,0, . . . }, for instance, have different energies, so both cannot occur in the same isolated system. It follows that, in looking for the configuration with the greatest weight, we must ensure that the configuration also satisfies the condition Constant total energy: ∑ i ni εi = E (16.4) where E is the total energy of the system. The second constraint is that, because the total number of molecules present is also fixed (at N), we cannot arbitrarily vary all the populations simultaneously. Thus, increasing the population of one state by 1 demands that the population of another state must be reduced by 1. Therefore, the search for the maximum value of W is also subject to the condition Constant total number of molecules: ∑ i ni = N (16.5) We show in Further information 16.1 that the populations in the configuration of greatest weight, subject to the two constraints in eqns 16.4 and 16.5, depend on the energy of the state according to the Boltzmann distribution: N! n0!n1!n2! . . . Comment 16.2 A more accurate form of Stirling’s approximation is x! ≈ (2π)1/2 xx+1 –2 e−x and is in error by less than 1 per cent when x is greater than about 10. We deal with far larger values of x, and the simplified version in eqn 16.2 is adequate. 564 16 STATISTICAL THERMODYNAMICS 1: THE CONCEPTS = (16.6a) where ε0 ≤ ε1 ≤ ε2 . . . . Equation 16.6a is the justification of the remark that a single parameter, here denoted β, determines the most probable populations of the states of the system. We shall see in Section 16.3b that β = (16.6b) where T is the thermodynamic temperature and k is Boltzmann’s constant. In other words, the thermodynamic temperature is the unique parameter that governs the most probable populations of states of a system at thermal equilibrium. In Further information 16.3, moreover, we see that β is a more natural measure of temperature than T itself. 16.2 The molecular partition function From now on we write the Boltzmann distribution as pi = (16.7) where pi is the fraction of molecules in the state i, pi = ni/N, and q is the molecular partition function: q = ∑ i e−βεi [16.8] Thesuminqissometimesexpressedslightlydifferently.Itmayhappenthatseveralstates have the same energy, and so give the same contribution to the sum. If, for example, gi states have the same energy εi (so the level is gi-fold degenerate), we could write q = ∑ levels i gie−βεi (16.9) where the sum is now over energy levels (sets of states with the same energy), not individual states. Example 16.1 Writing a partition function Write an expression for the partition function of a linear molecule (such as HCl) treated as a rigid rotor. Method To use eqn 16.9 we need to know (a) the energies of the levels, (b) the degeneracies, the number of states that belong to each level. Whenever calculating a partition function, the energies of the levels are expressed relative to 0 for the state oflowestenergy.TheenergylevelsofarigidlinearrotorwerederivedinSection13.5c. Answer From eqn 13.31, the energy levels of a linear rotor are hcBJ(J + 1), with J = 0, 1, 2, . . . . The state of lowest energy has zero energy, so no adjustment need be made to the energies given by this expression. Each level consists of 2J + 1 degenerate states. Therefore, gJ εJ q = ∞ ∑ J=0 (2J + 1)e−βhcBJ(J+1) The sum can be evaluated numerically by supplying the value of B (from spectroscopy or calculation) and the temperature. For reasons explained in Section 17.2b, 5 6 7 5 6 7e−βεi q 1 kT e−βεi ∑ i e−βεi ni N 16.2 THE MOLECULAR PARTITION FUNCTION 565 0 e 2 3 e e e Fig. 16.3 The equally spaced infinite array of energy levels used in the calculation of the partition function. A harmonic oscillator has the same spectrum of levels. 0 5 10 10 5 0 q kT/e Fig. 16.4 The partition function for the system shown in Fig.16.3 (a harmonic oscillator) as a function of temperature. Exploration Plot the partition function of a harmonic oscillator against temperature for several values of the energy separation ε. How does q vary with temperature when T is high, in the sense that kT >> ε (or βε << 1)? Comment 16.3 The sum of the infinite series S = 1 + x + x2 + · · · is obtained by multiplying both sides by x, which gives xS = x + x2 + x3 + · · · = S − 1 and hence S = 1/(1 − x). this expression applies only to unsymmetrical linear rotors (for instance, HCl, not CO2). Self-test 16.2 Write the partition function for a two-level system, the lower state (at energy 0) being nondegenerate, and the upper state (at an energy ε) doubly degenerate. [q = 1 + 2e−βε ] (a) An interpretation of the partition function Some insight into the significance of a partition function can be obtained by considering how q depends on the temperature. When T is close to zero, the parameter β = 1/kT is close to infinity. Then every term except one in the sum defining q is zero because each one has the form e−x with x → ∞. The exception is the term with ε0 ≡ 0 (or the g0 terms at zero energy if the ground state is g0-fold degenerate), because then ε0/kT ≡ 0 whatever the temperature, including zero. As there is only one surviving term when T = 0, and its value is g0, it follows that lim T→0 q = g0 (16.10) That is, at T = 0, the partition function is equal to the degeneracy of the ground state. Now consider the case when T is so high that for each term in the sum εj/kT ≈ 0. Because e−x = 1 when x = 0, each term in the sum now contributes 1. It follows that the sum is equal to the number of molecular states, which in general is infinite: lim T→∞ q = ∞ (16.11) In some idealized cases, the molecule may have only a finite number of states; then the upper limit of q is equal to the number of states. For example, if we were considering only the spin energy levels of a radical in a magnetic field, then there would be only two states (ms = ± 1 –2). The partition function for such a system can therefore be expected to rise towards 2 as T is increased towards infinity. We see that the molecular partition function gives an indication of the number of states that are thermally accessible to a molecule at the temperature of the system. At T = 0, only the ground level is accessible and q = g0. At very high temperatures, virtually all states are accessible, and q is correspondingly large. Example 16.2 Evaluating the partition function for a uniform ladder of energy levels Evaluate the partition function for a molecule with an infinite number of equally spaced nondegenerate energy levels (Fig. 16.3). These levels can be thought of as the vibrational energy levels of a diatomic molecule in the harmonic approximation. Method We expect the partition function to increase from 1 at T = 0 and approach infinity as T to ∞. To evaluate eqn 16.8 explicitly, note that 1 + x + x2 + · · · = Answer If the separation of neighbouring levels is ε, the partition function is q = 1 + e−βε + e−2βε + · · · = 1 + e−βε + (e−βε )2 + · · · = This expression is plotted in Fig. 16.4: notice that, as anticipated, q rises from 1 to infinity as the temperature is raised. 1 1 − e−βε 1 1 − x 566 16 STATISTICAL THERMODYNAMICS 1: THE CONCEPTS q 2 10 5 10 1.5 1.4 1.2 1 0 0.5 1 q kT/ kT/e e Fig. 16.5 The partition function for a two-level system as a function of temperature. The two graphs differ in the scale of the temperature axis to show the approach to 1 as T → 0 and the slow approach to 2 as T → ∞. Exploration Consider a three-level system with levels 0, ε, and 2ε. Plot the partition function against kT/ε. Low temperature High temperature be 3.0 1.0 0.7 0.3 q: 1.05 1.58 1.99 3.86 : Fig. 16.6 The populations of the energy levels of the system shown in Fig.16.3 at different temperatures, and the corresponding values of the partition function calculated in Example 16.2. Note that β = 1/kT. Exploration To visualize the content of Fig. 16.6 in a different way, plot the functions p0, p1, p2, and p3 against kT/ε. Self-test 16.3 Find and plot an expression for the partition function of a system with one state at zero energy and another state at the energy ε. [q = 1 + e−βε , Fig. 16.5] It follows from eqn 16.8 and the expression for q derived in Example 16.2 for a uniform ladder of states of spacing ε, q = (16.12) that the fraction of molecules in the state with energy εi is pi = = (1 − e−βε )e−βεi (16.13) Figure 16.6 shows how pi varies with temperature. At very low temperatures, where q is close to 1, only the lowest state is significantly populated. As the temperature is raised, the population breaks out of the lowest state, and the upper states become progressively more highly populated. At the same time, the partition function rises from 1 and its value gives an indication of the range of states populated. The name ‘partition function’ reflects the sense in which q measures how the total number of molecules is distributed—partitioned—over the available states. The corresponding expressions for a two-level system derived in Self-test 16.3 are p0 = p1 = (16.14) These functions are plotted in Fig. 16.7. Notice how the populations tend towards equality (p0 = 1 –2, p1 = 1 –2) as T → ∞. A common error is to suppose that all the molecules in the system will be found in the upper energy state when T = ∞; however, we see e−βε 1 + e−βε 1 1 + e−βε e−βεi q 1 1 − e−βε 16.2 THE MOLECULAR PARTITION FUNCTION 567 0 0 0.5 0.5 1 1 p p0 p1 0 0.5 1 0 5 10 p p0 p1 kT/ kT/e e Fig. 16.7 The fraction of populations of the two states of a two-level system as a function of temperature (eqn 16.14). Note that, as the temperature approaches infinity, the populations of the two states become equal (and the fractions both approach 0.5). Exploration Consider a three-level system with levels 0, ε, and 2ε. Plot the functions p0, p1, and p2 against kT/ε. from eqn 16.14 that, as T → ∞, the populations of states become equal. The same conclusion is true of multi-level systems too: as T → ∞, all states become equally populated. Example 16.3 Using the partition function to calculate a population Calculate the proportion of I2 molecules in their ground, first excited, and second excited vibrational states at 25°C. The vibrational wavenumber is 214.6 cm−1 . Method Vibrational energy levels have a constant separation (in the harmonic approximation, Section 13.9), so the partition function is given by eqn 16.12 and the populations by eqn 16.13. To use the latter equation, we identify the index i with the quantum number v, and calculate pv for v = 0, 1, and 2. At 298.15 K, kT/hc = 207.226 cm−1 . Answer First, we note that βε = = = 1.036 Then it follows from eqn 16.13 that the populations are pv = (1 − e−βε )e−vβε = 0.645e−1.036v Therefore, p0 = 0.645, p1 = 0.229, p2 = 0.081. The I-I bond is not stiff and the atoms are heavy: as a result, the vibrational energy separations are small and at room temperature several vibrational levels are significantly populated. The value of the partition function, q = 1.55, reflects this small but significant spread of populations. Self-test 16.4 At what temperature would the v = 1 level of I2 have (a) half the population of the ground state, (b) the same population as the ground state? [(a) 445 K, (b) infinite] 214.6 cm−1 207.226 cm−1 hc# kT 568 16 STATISTICAL THERMODYNAMICS 1: THE CONCEPTS Magnetic field on Magnetic field off Entropy,S A BC Temperature, T0 Fig. 16.8 The technique of adiabatic demagnetization is used to attain very low temperatures. The upper curve shows that variation of the entropy of a paramagnetic system in the absence of an applied field. The lower curve shows that variation in entropy when a field is applied and has made the electron magnets more orderly. The isothermal magnetization step is from A to B; the adiabatic demagnetization step (at constant entropy) is from B to C. It follows from our discussion of the partition function that to reach low temperatures it is necessary to devise strategies that populate the low energy levels of a system at the expense of high energy levels. Common methods used to reach very low temperatures include optical trapping and adiabatic demagnetization. In optical trapping, atoms in the gas phase are cooled by inelastic collisions with photons from intense laser beams, which act as walls of a very small container. Adiabatic demagnetization is based on the fact that, in the absence of a magnetic field, the unpaired electrons of a paramagnetic material are orientated at random, but in the presence of a magnetic field there are more β spins (ms = −1 –2) than α spins (ms = +1 –2). In thermodynamic terms, the application of a magnetic field lowers the entropy of a sample and, at a given temperature, the entropy of a sample is lower when the field is on than when it is off. Even lower temperatures can be reached if nuclear spins (which also behave like small magnets) are used instead of electron spins in the technique of adiabatic nuclear demagnetization, which has been used to cool a sample of silver to about 280 pK. In certain circumstances it is possible to achieve negative temperatures, and the equations derived later in this chapter can be extended to T < 0 with interesting consequences (see Further information 16.3). Illustration 16.2 Cooling a sample by adiabatic demagnetization Consider the situation summarized by Fig. 16.8. A sample of paramagnetic material, such as a d- or f-metal complex with several unpaired electrons, is cooled to about 1 K by using helium. The sample is then exposed to a strong magnetic field while it is surrounded by helium, which provides thermal contact with the cold reservoir. This magnetization step is isothermal, and energy leaves the system as heat while the electron spins adopt the lower energy state (AB in the illustration). Thermal contact between the sample and the surroundings is now broken by pumping away the helium and the magnetic field is reduced to zero. This step is adiabatic and effectively reversible, so the state of the sample changes from B to C. At the end of this step the sample is the same as it was at A except that it now has a lower entropy. That lower entropy in the absence of a magnetic field corresponds to a lower temperature. That is, adiabatic demagnetization has cooled the sample. (b) Approximations and factorizations In general, exact analytical expressions for partition functions cannot be obtained. However, closed approximate expressions can often be found and prove to be very important in a number of chemical and biochemical applications (Impact 16.1). For instance, the expression for the partition function for a particle of mass m free to move in a one-dimensional container of length X can be evaluated by making use of the fact that the separation of energy levels is very small and that large numbers of states are accessible at normal temperatures. As shown in the Justification below, in this case qX = 1/2 X (16.15) This expression shows that the partition function for translational motion increases with the length of the box and the mass of the particle, for in each case the separation of the energy levels becomes smaller and more levels become thermally accessible. For a given mass and length of the box, the partition function also increases with increasing temperature (decreasing β), because more states become accessible. D F 2πm h2 β A C 16.2 THE MOLECULAR PARTITION FUNCTION 569 Justification 16.2 The partition function for a particle in a one-dimensional box The energy levels of a molecule of mass m in a container of length X are given by eqn 9.4a with L = X: En = n = 1, 2, . . . The lowest level (n = 1) has energy h2 /8mX2 , so the energies relative to that level are εn = (n2 − 1)ε ε = h2 /8mX2 The sum to evaluate is therefore qX = ∞ ∑n=1 e−(n2 −1)βε The translational energy levels are very close together in a container the size of a typical laboratory vessel; therefore, the sum can be approximated by an integral: qX = Ύ ∞ 1 e−(n2 −1)βε dn ≈ Ύ ∞ 0 e−n2 βε dn The extension of the lower limit to n = 0 and the replacement of n2 − 1 by n2 introduces negligible error but turns the integral into standard form. We make the substitution x2 = n2 βε, implying dn = dx/(βε)1/2 , and therefore that π1/2 /2 qX = 1/2 Ύ ∞ 0 e−x2 dx = 1/2 = 1/2 X Another useful feature of partition functions is used to derive expressions when the energy of a molecule arises from several different, independent sources: if the energy is a sum of contributions from independent modes of motion, then the partition function is a product of partition functions for each mode of motion. For instance, suppose the molecule we are considering is free to move in three dimensions. We take the length of the container in the y-direction to be Y and that in the z-direction to be Z. The total energy of a molecule ε is the sum of its translational energies in all three directions: εn1n2n3 = εn1 (X) + εn2 (Y) + εn3 (Z) (16.16) where n1, n2, and n3 are the quantum numbers for motion in the x-, y-, and z-directions, respectively. Therefore, because ea+b+c = ea eb ec , the partition function factorizes as follows: q = ∑ all n e−βεn1 (X) −βεn2 (Y) −βεn3 (Z) = ∑ all n e−βεn1 (X) e−βεn2 (Y) e−βεn3 (Z) = ∑∑ n1 e−βεn1 (X) ∑ n2 e−βεn2 (Y) ∑ n3 e−βεn3 (Z) (16.17) = qXqYqZ It is generally true that, if the energy of a molecule can be written as the sum of independent terms, then the partition function is the corresponding product of individual contributions. D F A C D F A C D F A C D E F 2πm h2 β A B C D E F π1/2 2 A B C D E F 1 βε A B C D E F 1 βε A B C 5 6 7 n2 h2 8mX2 570 16 STATISTICAL THERMODYNAMICS 1: THE CONCEPTS Equation 16.15 gives the partition function for translational motion in the xdirection. The only change for the other two directions is to replace the length X by the lengths Y or Z. Hence the partition function for motion in three dimensions is q = 3/2 XYZ (16.18) The product of lengths XYZ is the volume, V, of the container, so we can write q = Λ = h 1/2 = (16.19) The quantity Λ has the dimensions of length and is called the thermal wavelength (sometimes the thermal de Broglie wavelength) of the molecule. The thermal wavelength decreases with increasing mass and temperature. As in the one-dimensional case, the partition function increases with the mass of the particle (as m3/2 ) and the volume of the container (as V); for a given mass and volume, the partition function increases with temperature (as T3/2 ). Illustration 16.3 Calculating the translational partition function To calculate the translational partition function of an H2 molecule confined to a 100 cm3 vessel at 25°C we use m = 2.016 u; then Λ = = 7.12 × 10−11 m where we have used 1 J = 1 kg m2 s−2 . Therefore, q = = 2.77 × 1026 About 1026 quantum states are thermally accessible, even at room temperature and for this light molecule. Many states are occupied if the thermal wavelength (which inthiscaseis71.2pm)issmallcomparedwiththelineardimensionsofthecontainer. Self-test 16.5 Calculate the translational partition function for a D2 molecule under the same conditions. [q = 7.8 × 1026 , 23/2 times larger] The validity of the approximations that led to eqn 16.19 can be expressed in terms of the average separation of the particles in the container, d. We do not have to worry about the role of the Pauli principle on the occupation of states if there are many states available for each molecule. Because q is the total number of accessible states, the average number of states per molecule is q/N. For this quantity to be large, we require V/NΛ3 >> 1. However, V/N is the volume occupied by a single particle, and therefore the average separation of the particles is d = (V/N)1/3 . The condition for there being many states available per molecule is therefore d3 /Λ3 >> 1, and therefore d >> Λ. That is, for eqn 16.19 to be valid, the average separation of the particles must be much greater than their thermal wavelength. For H2 molecules at 1 bar and 298 K, the average separation is 3 nm, which is significantly larger than their thermal wavelength (71.2 pm, Illustration 16.3). 1.00 × 10−4 m3 (7.12 × 10−11 m)3 6.626 × 10−34 J s {2π × (2.016 × 1.6605 × 10−27 kg) × (1.38 × 10−23 J K−1 ) × (298 K)}1/2 h (2πmkT)1/2 D F β 2πm A C V Λ3 D F 2πm h2 β A C I16.1 IMPACT ON BIOCHEMISTRY: THE HELIX–COIL TRANSITION IN POLYPEPTIDES 571 IMPACT ON BIOCHEMISTRY I16.1 The helix–coil transition in polypeptides Proteins are polymers that attain well defined three-dimensional structures both in solution and in biological cells. They are polypeptides formed from different amino acids strung together by the peptide link, -CONH-. Hydrogen bonds between amino acids of a polypeptide give rise to stable helical or sheet structures, which may collapse into a random coil when certain conditions are changed. The unwinding of a helix into a random coil is a cooperative transition, in which the polymer becomes increasingly more susceptible to structural changes once the process has begun. We examine here a model grounded in the principles of statistical thermodynamics that accounts for the cooperativity of the helix–coil transition in polypeptides. To calculate the fraction of polypeptide molecules present as helix or coil we need to set up the partition function for the various states of the molecule. To illustrate the approach, consider a short polypeptide with four amino acid residues, each labelled h if it contributes to a helical region and c if it contributes to a random coil region. We suppose that conformations hhhh and cccc contribute terms q0 and q4, respectively, to the partition function q. Then we assume that each of the four conformations with one c amino acid (such as hchh) contributes q1. Similarly, each of the six states with two c amino acids contributes a term q2, and each of the four states with three c amino acids contributes a term q3. The partition function is then q = q0 + 4q1 + 6q2 + 4q3 + q4 = q0 1 + + + + We shall now suppose that each partition function differs from q0 only by the energy of each conformation relative to hhhh, and write = e−(εi−ε0)/kT Next, we suppose that the conformational transformations are non-cooperative, in the sense that the energy associated with changing one h amino acid into one c amino acid has the same value regardless of how many h or c amino acid residues are in the reactant or product state and regardless of where in the chain the conversion occurs. That is, we suppose that the difference in energy between ci h4−i and ci+1 h3−i has the same value γ for all i. This assumption implies that εi − ε0 = iγ and therefore that q = q0(1 + 4s + 6s2 + 4s3 + s4 ) s = e−Γ/RT (16.20) where Γ = NAγ and s is called the stability parameter. The term in parentheses has the form of the binomial expansion of (1 + s)4 . = 4 ∑ i=0 C(4,i)si with C(4,i) = (16.21) which we interpret as the number of ways in which a state with i c amino acids can be formed. The extension of this treatment to take into account a longer chain of residues is now straightforward: we simply replace the upper limit of 4 in the sum by n: = n ∑ i=0 C(n,i)si (16.22) A cooperative transformation is more difficult to accommodate, and depends on building a model of how neighbours facilitate each other’s conformational change. In q q0 4! (4 − i)!i! q q0 qi q0 D F q4 q0 4q3 q0 6q2 q0 4q1 q0 A C Comment 16.4 The binomial expansion of (1 + x)n is (1 + x)n = n ∑i=0 C(n,i)xi , with C(n,i) = n! (n − i)!i! 572 16 STATISTICAL THERMODYNAMICS 1: THE CONCEPTS the simple zipper model, conversion from h to c is allowed only if a residue adjacent to the one undergoing the conversion is already a c residue. Thus, the zipper model allows a transition of the type . . .hhhch. . . → . . .hhhcc. . . , but not a transition of the type . . .hhhch. . . → . . .hchch. . . . The only exception to this rule is, of course, the very first conversion from h to c in a fully helical chain. Cooperativity is included in the zipper model by assuming that the first conversion from h to c, called the nucleation step, is less favourable than the remaining conversions and replacing s for that step by σs, where σ << 1. Each subsequent step is called a propagation step and has a stability parameter s. In Problem 16.24, you are invited to show that the partition function is: q = 1 + n ∑ i=1 Z(n,i)σsi (16.23) where Z(n,i) is the number of ways in which a state with a number i of c amino acids can be formed under the strictures of the zipper model. Because Z(n,i) = n − i + 1 (see Problem 16.24), q = 1 + σ(n + 1) n ∑ i=1 si − σ n ∑ i=1 isi (16.24) After evaluating both geometric series by using the two relations n ∑ i=1 xi = n ∑ i=1 ixi = [nxn+1 − (n + 1)xn + 1] we find q = 1 + The fraction pi = qi/q of molecules that has a number i of c amino acids is pi = [(n − i + 1)σsi ]/q and the mean value of i is then ͗i͘ = ∑iipi. Figure 16.9 shows the distribution of pi for various values of s with σ = 5.0 × 10−3 . We see that most of the polypeptide chains remain largely helical when s < 1 and that most of the chains exist largely as random coils when s > 1. When s = 1, there is a more widespread distribution of length of random coil segments. Because the degree of conversion, θ, of a polypeptide with n amino acids to a random coil is defined as θ = ͗i͘/n, it is possible to show (see Problem 16.24) that θ = ln q (16.25) This is a general result that applies to any model of the helix–coil transition in which the partition function q is expressed as a function of the stability parameter s. A more sophisticated model for the helix–coil transition must allow for helical segments to form in different regions of a long polypeptide chain, with the nascent helices being separated by shrinking coil segments. Calculations based on this more complete Zimm–Bragg model give θ = 1 –2 1 + (16.26) Figure 16.10 shows plots of θ against s for several values of σ. The curves show the sigmoidal shape characteristic of cooperative behaviour. There is a sudden surge of transition to a random coil as s passes through 1 and, the smaller the parameter σ, the greater the sharpness and hence the greater the cooperativity of the transition. That is, the harder it is to get coil formation started, the sharper the transition from helix to coil. D F (s − 1) + 2σ [(s − 1)2 + 4sσ]1/2 A C d d(ln s) 1 n σs[sn+1 − (n + 1)sn + 1] (s − 1)2 x (x − 1)2 xn+1 − x x − 10 5 10 15 20 0.05 0.1 0.15 pi 1 0.82 1.5 s i 0 Fig. 16.9 The distribution of pi, the fraction of molecules that has a number i of c amino acids for s = 0.8 (͗i͘ = 1.1), 1.0 (͗i͘ = 3.8), and 1.5 (͗i͘ = 15.9), with σ = 5.0 × 10−3 . (,)s 0 0.5 1 1.5 2 0 0.5 1 0.01 0.001 0.0001 s qs Fig. 16.10 Plots of the degree of conversion θ, against s for several values of σ. The curves show the sigmoidal shape characteristics of cooperative behaviour. 16.3 THE INTERNAL ENERGY 573 0 0.5 1 0.2 0.4 0 0 5 10 E/NE/N 0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.5 kT/ kT/ e e ee Fig. 16.11 The total energy of a two-level system (expressed as a multiple of Nε) as a function of temperature, on two temperature scales. The graph at the top shows the slow rise away from zero energy at low temperatures; the slope of the graph at T = 0 is 0 (that is, the heat capacity is zero at T = 0). The graph below shows the slow rise to 0.5 as T → ∞ as both states become equally populated (see Fig. 16.7). Exploration Draw graphs similar to those in Fig. 16.11 for a three-level system with levels 0, ε, and 2ε. The internal energy and the entropy The importance of the molecular partition function is that it contains all the information needed to calculate the thermodynamic properties of a system of independent particles. In this respect, q plays a role in statistical thermodynamics very similar to that played by the wavefunction in quantum mechanics: q is a kind of thermal wavefunction. 16.3 The internal energy We shall begin to unfold the importance of q by showing how to derive an expression for the internal energy of the system. (a) The relation between U and q The total energy of the system relative to the energy of the lowest state is E = ∑ i niεi (16.27) Because the most probable configuration is so strongly dominating, we can use the Boltzmann distribution for the populations and write E = ∑ i εie−βεi (16.28) To manipulate this expression into a form involving only q we note that εie−βεi = − e−βεi It follows that E = − ∑ i e−βεi = − ∑ i e−βεi = − (16.29) Illustration 16.4 The energy of a two-level system From the two-level partition function q = 1 + e−βε , we can deduce that the total energy of N two-level systems is E = − (1 + e−βε ) = = This function is plotted in Fig. 16.11. Notice how the energy is zero at T = 0, when only the lower state (at the zero of energy) is occupied, and rises to 1 –2Nε as T → ∞, when the two levels become equally populated. There are several points in relation to eqn 16.29 that need to be made. Because ε0 = 0 (remember that we measure all energies from the lowest available level), E should be interpreted as the value of the internal energy relative to its value at T = 0, U(0). Therefore, to obtain the conventional internal energy U, we must add the internal energy at T = 0: U = U(0) + E (16.30) Nε 1 + eβε Nεe−βε 1 + e−βε d dβ D F N 1 + e−βε A C dq dβ N q d dβ N q d dβ N q d dβ N q 574 16 STATISTICAL THERMODYNAMICS 1: THE CONCEPTS Secondly, because the partition function may depend on variables other than the temperature (for example, the volume), the derivative with respect to β in eqn 16.29 is actually a partial derivative with these other variables held constant. The complete expression relating the molecular partition function to the thermodynamic internal energy of a system of independent molecules is therefore U = U(0) − V (16.31a) An equivalent form is obtained by noting that dx/x = d ln x: U = U(0) − N V (16.31b) These two equations confirm that we need know only the partition function (as a function of temperature) to calculate the internal energy relative to its value at T = 0. (b) The value of β We now confirm that the parameter β, which we have anticipated is equal to 1/kT, does indeed have that value. To do so, we compare the equipartition expression for the internal energy of a monatomic perfect gas, which from Molecular interpretation 2.2 we know to be U = U(0) + 3 –2nRT (16.32a) with the value calculated from the translational partition function (see the following Justification), which is U = U(0) + (16.32b) It follows by comparing these two expressions that β = = = (16.33) (We have used N = nNA, where n is the amount of gas molecules, NA is Avogadro’s constant, and R = NAk.) Although we have proved that β = 1/kT by examining a very specific example, the translational motion of a perfect monatomic gas, the result is general (see Example 17.1 and Further reading). Justification 16.3 The internal energy of a perfect gas To use eqn 16.31, we introduce the translational partition function from eqn 16.19: V = V = V = −3 Then we note from the formula for Λ in eqn 16.19 that = = × = and so obtain V = − 3V 2βΛ3 D E F ∂q ∂β A B C Λ 2β h (2πm)1/2 1 2β1/2 5 6 7 hβ1/2 (2πm)1/2 1 2 3 d dβ dΛ dβ dΛ dβ V Λ4 1 Λ3 d dβ D E F V Λ3 ∂ ∂β A B C D E F ∂q ∂β A B C 1 kT nNA nNAkT N nRT 3N 2β D F ∂ ln q ∂β A C D F ∂q ∂β A C N q 16.4 THE STATISTICAL ENTROPY 575 Then, by eqn 16.31a, U = U(0) − N − = U(0) + as in eqn 16.32b. 16.4 The statistical entropy If it is true that the partition function contains all thermodynamic information, then it must be possible to use it to calculate the entropy as well as the internal energy. Because we know (from Section 3.2) that entropy is related to the dispersal of energy and that the partition function is a measure of the number of thermally accessible states, we can be confident that the two are indeed related. We shall develop the relation between the entropy and the partition function in two stages. In Further information 16.2, we justify one of the most celebrated equations in statistical thermodynamics, the Boltzmann formula for the entropy: S = k ln W [16.34] In this expression, W is the weight of the most probable configuration of the system. In the second stage, we express W in terms of the partition function. The statistical entropy behaves in exactly the same way as the thermodynamic entropy. Thus, as the temperature is lowered, the value of W, and hence of S, decreases because fewer configurations are compatible with the total energy. In the limit T → 0, W = 1, so ln W = 0, because only one configuration (every molecule in the lowest level) is compatible with E = 0. It follows that S → 0 as T → 0, which is compatible with the Third Law of thermodynamics, that the entropies of all perfect crystals approach the same value as T → 0 (Section 3.4). Now we relate the Boltzmann formula for the entropy to the partition function. To do so, we substitute the expression for ln W given in eqn 16.3 into eqn 16.34 and, as shown in the Justification below, obtain S = + Nk ln q (16.35) Justification 16.4 The statistical entropy The first stage is to use eqn 16.3 (ln W = N ln N − ∑i ni ln ni) and N = ∑ini to write S = k∑i (ni ln N − ni ln ni) = −k∑i ni ln = −Nk∑i pi ln pi where pi = ni /N, the fraction of molecules in state i. It follows from eqn 16.7 that ln pi = −βεi − ln q and therefore that S = −Nk(−β∑i piεi − ∑i pi ln q) = kβ{U − U(0)} + Nk ln q We have used the fact that the sum over the pi is equal to 1 and that (from eqns 16.27 and 16.30) N ∑i piεi = ∑i Npiεi = ∑i Npiεi = ∑i niεi = E = U − U(0) We have already established that β = 1/kT, so eqn 16.35 immediately follows. ni N U − U(0) T 3N 2β D E F 3V 2βΛ3 A B C D E F Λ3 V A B C 576 16 STATISTICAL THERMODYNAMICS 1: THE CONCEPTS 0 5 10 4 2 0 SNk/ kT/e Fig. 16.12 The temperature variation of the entropy of the system shown in Fig. 16.3 (expressed here as a multiple of Nk). The entropy approaches zero as T → 0, and increases without limit as T → ∞. Exploration Plot the function dS/dT, the temperature coefficient of the entropy, against kT/ε. Is there a temperature at which this coefficient passes through a maximum? If you find a maximum, explain its physical origins. 0 0 0.5 0.5 1 1 SNk/ 0 0.5 1 0 5 10 SNk/ ln 2ln 2 kT/ kT/e e Fig. 16.13 The temperature variation of the entropy of a two-level system (expressed as a multiple of Nk). As T → ∞, the two states become equally populated and S approaches Nk ln 2. Exploration Draw graphs similar to those in Fig. 16.13 for a three-level system with levels 0, ε, and 2ε. Example 16.4 Calculating the entropy of a collection of oscillators Calculate the entropy of a collection of N independent harmonic oscillators, and evaluate it using vibrational data for I2 vapour at 25°C (Example 16.3). Method To use eqn 16.35, we use the partition function for a molecule with evenly spaced vibrational energy levels, eqn 16.12. With the partition function available, the internal energy can be found by differentiation (as in eqn 16.31a), and the two expressions then combined to give S. Answer The molecular partition function as given in eqn 16.12 is q = The internal energy is obtained by using eqn 16.31a: U − U(0) = − V = = The entropy is therefore S = Nk − ln(1 − eβε ) This function is plotted in Fig. 16.12. For I2 at 25°C, βε = 1.036 (Example 16.3), so Sm = 8.38 J K−1 mol−1 . Self-test 16.6 Evaluate the molar entropy of N two-level systems and plot the resulting expression. What is the entropy when the two states are equally thermally accessible? [S/Nk = βε/(1 + eβε ) + ln(1 + e−βε ); see Fig. 16.13; S = Nk ln 2] 5 6 7 βε eβε − 1 1 2 3 Nε e−βε − 1 Nεe−βε 1 − e−βε D F ∂q ∂β A C N q 1 1 − e−βε 16.5 THE CANONICAL ENSEMBLE 577 The canonical partition function In this section we see how to generalize our conclusions to include systems composed of interacting molecules. We shall also see how to obtain the molecular partition function from the more general form of the partition function developed here. 16.5 The canonical ensemble The crucial new concept we need when treating systems of interacting particles is the ‘ensemble’. Like so many scientific terms, the term has basically its normal meaning of ‘collection’, but it has been sharpened and refined into a precise significance. (a) The concept of ensemble To set up an ensemble, we take a closed system of specified volume, composition, and temperature, and think of it as replicated Ñ times (Fig. 16.14). All the identical closed systems are regarded as being in thermal contact with one another, so they can exchange energy. The total energy of all the systems is L and, because they are in thermal equilibrium with one another, they all have the same temperature, T. This imaginary collection of replications of the actual system with a common temperature is called the canonical ensemble. The word ‘canon’ means ‘according to a rule’. There are two other important ensembles. In the microcanonical ensemble the condition of constant temperature is replaced by the requirement that all the systems should have exactly the same energy: each system is individually isolated. In the grand canonical ensemble the volume and temperature of each system is the same, but they are open, which means that matter can be imagined as able to pass between the systems; the composition of each one may fluctuate, but now the chemical potential is the same in each system: Microcanonical ensemble: N, V, E common Canonical ensemble: N, V, T common Grand canonical ensemble: µ, V, T common The important point about an ensemble is that it is a collection of imaginary replications of the system, so we are free to let the number of members be as large as we like; when appropriate, we can let Ñ become infinite. The number of members of the ensemble in a state with energy Ei is denoted ñi, and we can speak of the configuration of the ensemble (by analogy with the configuration of the system used in Section 16.1) and its weight, M. Note that Ñ is unrelated to N, the number of molecules in the actual system; Ñ is the number of imaginary replications of that system. (b) Dominating configurations Just as in Section 16.1, some of the configurations of the ensemble will be very much more probable than others. For instance, it is very unlikely that the whole of the total energy, L, will accumulate in one system. By analogy with the earlier discussion, we can anticipate that there will be a dominating configuration, and that we can evaluate the thermodynamic properties by taking the average over the ensemble using that single, most probable, configuration. In the thermodynamic limit of Ñ → ∞, this dominating configuration is overwhelmingly the most probable, and it dominates the properties of the system virtually completely. The quantitative discussion follows the argument in Section 16.1 with the modification that N and ni are replaced by Ñ and ñi. The weight of a configuration {ñ0,ñ1, . . . } is N, V, T N, V, T 20 N, V, T N, V, T N, V, T N, V, T N, V, T 1 2 3 Fig. 16.14 A representation of the canonical ensemble, in this case for Ñ = 20. The individual replications of the actual system all have the same composition and volume. They are all in mutual thermal contact, and so all have the same temperature. Energy may be transferred between them as heat, and so they do not all have the same energy. The total energy L of all 20 replications is a constant because the ensemble is isolated overall. 578 16 STATISTICAL THERMODYNAMICS 1: THE CONCEPTS M = (16.36) The configuration of greatest weight, subject to the constraints that the total energy of the ensemble is constant at L and that the total number of members is fixed at Ñ, is given by the canonical distribution: = Q = ∑ i e−βEi (16.37) The quantity Q, which is a function of the temperature, is called the canonical partition function. (c) Fluctuations from the most probable distribution The canonical distribution in eqn 16.37 is only apparently an exponentially decreasing function of the energy of the system. We must appreciate that eqn 16.37 gives the probability of occurrence of members in a single state i of the entire system of energy Ei. There may in fact be numerous states with almost identical energies. For example, in a gas the identities of the molecules moving slowly or quickly can change without necessarily affecting the total energy. The density of states, the number of states in an energy range divided by the width of the range (Fig. 16.15), is a very sharply increasing function of energy. It follows that the probability of a member of an ensemble having a specified energy (as distinct from being in a specified state) is given by eqn 16.37, a sharply decreasing function, multiplied by a sharply increasing function (Fig. 16.16). Therefore, the overall distribution is a sharply peaked function. We conclude that most members of the ensemble have an energy very close to the mean value. 16.6 The thermodynamic information in the partition function Like the molecular partition function, the canonical partition function carries all the thermodynamic information about a system. However, Q is more general than q because it does not assume that the molecules are independent. We can therefore use Q to discuss the properties of condensed phases and real gases where molecular interactions are important. (a) The internal energy If the total energy of the ensemble is L, and there are Ñ members, the average energy of a member is E = L/Ñ. We use this quantity to calculate the internal energy of the system in the limit of Ñ (and L) approaching infinity: U = U(0) + E = U(0) + L/Ñ as Ñ → ∞ (16.38) The fraction, "i, of members of the ensemble in a state i with energy Ei is given by the analogue of eqn 16.7 as "i = (16.39) It follows that the internal energy is given by U = U(0) + ∑ i "iEi = U(0) + ∑ i Eie−βEi (16.40) 1 Q e−βEi Q e−βEi Q ñi Ñ Ñ! ñ0!ñ1! . . . Energy Number of states Width of range Fig. 16.15 The energy density of states is the number of states in an energy range divided by the width of the range. Probability of state Number of states Probability of energy Energy Fig. 16.16 To construct the form of the distribution of members of the canonical ensemble in terms of their energies, we multiply the probability that any one is in a state of given energy, eqn 16.39, by the number of states corresponding to that energy (a steeply rising function). The product is a sharply peaked function at the mean energy, which shows that almost all the members of the ensemble have that energy. 16.7 INDEPENDENT MOLECULES 579 By the same argument that led to eqn 16.31, U = U(0) − V = U(0) − V (16.41) (b) The entropy The total weight, M, of a configuration of the ensemble is the product of the average weight W of each member of the ensemble, M = WÑ . Hence, we can calculate S from S = k lnW = k lnM1/Ñ = lnM (16.42) It follows, by the same argument used in Section 16.4, that S = + k ln Q (16.43) 16.7 Independent molecules We shall now see how to recover the molecular partition function from the more general canonical partition function when the molecules are independent. When the molecules are independent and distinguishable (in the sense to be described), the relation between Q and q is Q = qN (16.44) Justification 16.5 The relation between Q and q The total energy of a collection of N independent molecules is the sum of the energies of the molecules. Therefore, we can write the total energy of a state i of the system as Ei = εi(1) + εi(2) + · · · + εi(N) In this expression, εi(1) is the energy of molecule 1 when the system is in the state i, εi(2) the energy of molecule 2 when the system is in the same state i, and so on. The canonical partition function is then Q = ∑i e−βεi(1)−βεi(2)− · · · −βεi(N) The sum over the states of the system can be reproduced by letting each molecule enter all its own individual states (although we meet an important proviso shortly). Therefore, instead of summing over the states i of the system, we can sum over all the individual states i of molecule 1, all the states i of molecule 2, and so on. This rewriting of the original expression leads to Q = ∑i e−βεi ∑i e−βεi · · · ∑i e−βεi = ∑i e−βεi N = qN (a) Distinguishable and indistinguishable molecules If all the molecules are identical and free to move through space, we cannot distinguish them and the relation Q = qN is not valid. Suppose that molecule 1 is in some state a, molecule 2 is in b, and molecule 3 is in c, then one member of the ensemble has an energy E = εa + εb + εc. This member, however, is indistinguishable from one formed by putting molecule 1 in state b, molecule 2 in state c, and molecule 3 in state a, or some other permutation. There are six such permutations in all, and N! in D E F A B C D E F A B C D E F A B C D E F A B C U − U(0) T k Ñ D F ∂ ln Q ∂β A C D F ∂Q ∂β A C 1 Q 580 16 STATISTICAL THERMODYNAMICS 1: THE CONCEPTS general. In the case of indistinguishable molecules, it follows that we have counted too many states in going from the sum over system states to the sum over molecular states, so writing Q = qN overestimates the value of Q. The detailed argument is quite involved, but at all except very low temperatures it turns out that the correction factor is 1/N!. Therefore: • For distinguishable independent molecules: Q = qN (16.45a) • For indistinguishable independent molecules: Q = qN /N! (16.45b) For molecules to be indistinguishable, they must be of the same kind: an Ar atom is never indistinguishable from a Ne atom. Their identity, however, is not the only criterion. Each identical molecule in a crystal lattice, for instance, can be ‘named’ with a set of coordinates. Identical molecules in a lattice can therefore be treated as distinguishable because their sites are distinguishable, and we use eqn 16.45a. On the other hand, identical molecules in a gas are free to move to different locations, and there is no way of keeping track of the identity of a given molecule; we therefore use eqn 16.45b. (b) The entropy of a monatomic gas An important application of the previous material is the derivation (as shown in the Justification below) of the Sackur–Tetrode equation for the entropy of a monatomic gas: S = nR ln Λ = (16.46a) This equation implies that the molar entropy of a perfect gas of high molar mass is greater than one of low molar mass under the same conditions (because the former has more thermally accessible translational states). Because the gas is perfect, we can use the relation V = nRT/p to express the entropy in terms of the pressure as S = nR ln (16.46b) Justification 16.6 The Sackur–Tetrode equation For a gas of independent molecules, Q may be replaced by qN /N!, with the result that eqn 16.43 becomes S = + Nk ln q − k ln N! Because the number of molecules (N = nNA) in a typical sample is large, we can use Stirling’s approximation (eqn 16.2) to write S = + nR ln q − nR ln N + nR The only mode of motion for a gas of atoms is translation, and the partition function is q = V/Λ3 (eqn 16.19), where Λ is the thermal wavelength. The internal energy is given by eqn 16.32, so the entropy is S = 3–2 nR + nR ln − ln nNA + 1 = nR ln e3/2 + ln − ln nNA + ln e which rearranges into eqn 16.46. D E F V Λ3 A B C D E F V Λ3 A B C U − U(0) T U − U(0) T D F e5/2 kT pΛ3 A C h (2πmkT)1/2 D F e5/2 V nNAΛ3 A C CHECKLIST OF KEY IDEAS 581 (a) (b) Fig. 16.17 As the width of a container is increased (going from (a) to (b)), the energy levels become closer together (as 1/L2 ), and as a result more are thermally accessible at a given temperature. Consequently, the entropy of the system rises as the container expands. Checklist of key ideas 1. The instantaneous configuration of a system of N molecules is the specification of the set of populations n0, n1, . . . of the energy levels ε0, ε1, . . . . The weight W of a configuration is given by W = N!/n0!n1! . . . . 2. The Boltzmann distribution gives the numbers of molecules in each state of a system at any temperature: Ni = Ne−βεi/q, β = 1/kT. 3. The partition function is defined as q = ∑je−βεj and is an indication of the number of thermally accessible states at the temperature of interest. 4. The internal energy is U(T) = U(0) + E, with E = −(N/q)(∂q/∂β)V = −N(∂ ln q/∂β)V. 5. The Boltzmann formula for the entropy is S = k ln W, where W is the number of different ways in which the molecules of a system can be arranged while keeping the same total energy. 6. The entropy in terms of the partition function is S = {U − U(0)}/T + Nk ln q (distinguishable molecules) or S = {U − U(0)}/T + Nk ln q − Nk(ln N − 1) (indistinguishable molecules). 7. The canonical ensemble is an imaginary collection of replications of the actual system with a common temperature. 8. The canonical distribution is given by ñi/Ñ = e−βEi/∑je−βEj. The canonical partition function, Q = ∑ie−βEi. 9. The internal energy and entropy of an ensemble are, respectively, U = U(0) − (∂ ln Q/∂β)V and S = {U − U(0)}/T + k ln Q. 10. For distinguishable independent molecules we write Q = qN . For indistinguishable independent molecules we write Q = qN /N!. 11. The Sackur–Tetrode equation, eqn 16.46, is an expression for the entropy of a monatomic gas. Example 16.5 Using the Sackur–Tetrode equation Calculate the standard molar entropy of gaseous argon at 25°C. Method To calculate the molar entropy, Sm, from eqn 16.46b, divide both sides by n. To calculate the standard molar entropy, S7 m, set p = p7 in the expression for Sm: S7 m = R ln Answer The mass of an Ar atom is m = 39.95 u. At 25°C, its thermal wavelength is 16.0 pm (by the same kind of calculation as in Illustration 16.3). Therefore, S7 m = R ln = 18.6R = 155 J K−1 mol−1 We can anticipate, on the basis of the number of accessible states for a lighter molecule, that the standard molar entropy of Ne is likely to be smaller than for Ar; its actual value is 17.60R at 298 K. Self-test 16.7 Calculate the translational contribution to the standard molar entropy of H2 at 25°C. [14.2R] The Sackur–Tetrode equation implies that, when a monatomic perfect gas expands isothermally from Vi to Vf, its entropy changes by ∆S = nR ln(aVf) − nR ln(aVi) = nR ln (16.47) where aV is the collection of quantities inside the logarithm of eqn 16.46a. This is exactly the expression we obtained by using classical thermodynamics (Example 3.1). Now, though, we see that that classical expression is in fact a consequence of the increase in the number of accessible translational states when the volume of the container is increased (Fig. 16.17). Vf Vi 5 6 7 e5/2 × (4.12 × 10−21 J) (105 N m−2 ) × (1.60 × 10−11 m)3 1 2 3 D F e5/2 kT p7 Λ3 A C 582 16 STATISTICAL THERMODYNAMICS 1: THE CONCEPTS Further reading Articles and texts D. Chandler, Introduction to modern statistical mechanics. Oxford University Press (1987). D.A. McQuarrie and J.D. Simon, Molecular thermodynamics. University Science Books, Sausalito (1999). K.E. van Holde, W.C. Johnson, and P.S. Ho, Principles of physical biochemistry. Prentice Hall, Upper Saddle River (1998). J. Wisniak, Negative absolute temperatures, a novelty. J. Chem. Educ. 77, 518 (2000). Further information Further information 16.1 The Boltzmann distribution We remarked in Section 16.1 that ln W is easier to handle than W. Therefore, to find the form of the Boltzmann distribution, we look for the condition for ln W being a maximum rather than dealing directly with W. Because ln W depends on all the ni, when a configuration changes and the ni change to ni + dni, the function ln W changes to ln W + d ln W, where d ln W = ∑i dni All this expression states is that a change in ln W is the sum of contributions arising from changes in each value of ni. At a maximum, d ln W = 0. However, when the ni change, they do so subject to the two constraints ∑i εidni = 0 ∑i dni = 0 (16.48) The first constraint recognizes that the total energy must not change, and the second recognizes that the total number of molecules must not change. These two constraints prevent us from solving d ln W = 0 simply by setting all (∂ ln W/∂ni) = 0 because the dni are not all independent. The way to take constraints into account was devised by the French mathematician Lagrange, and is called the method of undetermined multipliers. The technique is described in Appendix 2. All we need here is the rule that a constraint should be multiplied by a constant and then added to the main variation equation. The variables are then treated as though they were all independent, and the constants are evaluated at the end of the calculation. We employ the technique as follows. The two constraints in eqn 16.48 are multiplied by the constants −β and α, respectively (the minus sign in −β has been included for future convenience), and then added to the expression for d ln W: d ln W = ∑i dni + α∑i dni − β∑i εidni = ∑i + α − βεi dni 5 6 7 D E F ∂ ln W ∂ni A B C 1 2 3 D E F ∂ ln W ∂ni A B C D E F ∂ lnW ∂ni A B C All the dni are now treated as independent. Hence the only way of satisfying d ln W = 0 is to require that, for each i, + α − βεi = 0 (16.49) when the ni have their most probable values. Differentiation of ln W as given in eqn 16.3 with respect to ni gives = − ∑j The derivative of the first term is obtained as follows: = ln N + N = ln N + = ln N + 1 The ln N in the first term on the right in the second line arises because N = n1 + n2 + · · · and so the derivative of N with respect to any of the ni is 1: that is, ∂N/∂ni = 1. The second term on the right in the second line arises because ∂(ln N)/∂ni = (1/N)∂N/∂ni. The final 1 is then obtained in the same way as in the preceding remark, by using ∂N/∂ni = 1. For the derivative of the second term we first note that = Morever, if i ≠ j, nj is independent of ni, so ∂nj/∂ni = 0. However, if i = j, = = 1 Therefore, = δij ∂nj ∂ni ∂nj ∂nj ∂nj ∂ni D E F ∂nj ∂ni A B C 1 nj ∂ ln nj ∂ni ∂N ∂ni D E F ∂ ln N ∂ni A B C D E F ∂N ∂ni A B C ∂(N ln N) ∂ni ∂(nj ln nj) ∂ni ∂(N ln N) ∂ni ∂ ln W ∂ni ∂ ln W ∂ni FURTHER INFORMATION 583 with δij the Kronecker delta (δij = 1 if i = j, δij = 0 otherwise). Then ∑j = ∑j ln nj + nj = ∑j ln nj + = ∑j (ln nj + 1) = ∑j δij(ln nj + 1) = ln ni + 1 and therefore = −(lnni + 1) + (ln N + 1) = −ln It follows from eqn 16.49 that −ln + α − βεi = 0 and therefore that = eα−βεi At this stage we note that N = ∑i ni = ∑i Neα−βεi = Neα ∑i eβεi Because the N cancels on each side of this equality, it follows that eα = (16.50) and = eα−βεi = eα e−βεi = e−βεi which is eqn 16.6a. Further information 16.2 The Boltzmann formula A change in the internal energy U = U(0) + ∑i niεi (16.51) may arise from either a modification of the energy levels of a system (when εi changes to εi + dεi) or from a modification of the populations (when ni changes to ni + dni). The most general change is therefore dU = dU(0) + ∑i nidεi + ∑i εidni (16.52) Because the energy levels do not change when a system is heated at constant volume (Fig. 16.18), in the absence of all changes other than heating dU = ∑i εidni 1 ∑j e−βεj ni N 1 ∑j e−βεj ni N ni N ni N ∂ ln W ∂ni D E F ∂nj ∂ni A B C 5 6 7 D E F ∂nj ∂ni A B C D E F ∂nj ∂ni A B C 1 2 3 5 6 7 D E F ∂ ln nj ∂ni A B C D E F ∂nj ∂ni A B C 1 2 3 ∂(nj ln nj) ∂ni We know from thermodynamics (and specifically from eqn 3.43) that under the same conditions dU = dqrev = TdS Therefore, dS = = kβ∑i εidni (16.53) For changes in the most probable configuration (the only one we need consider), we rearrange eqn 16.49 to βεi = + α ∂ ln W ∂ni dU T HeatWork (a) (b) Fig. 16.18 (a) When a system is heated, the energy levels are unchanged but their populations are changed. (b) When work is done on a system, the energy levels themselves are changed. The levels in this case are the one-dimensional particle-in-a-box energy levels of Chapter 9: they depend on the size of the container and move apart as its length is decreased. 584 16 STATISTICAL THERMODYNAMICS 1: THE CONCEPTS and find that dS = k∑i dni + kα∑i dni But because the number of molecules is constant, the sum over the dni is zero. Hence dS = k∑i dni = k(d lnW) This relation strongly suggests the definition S = k ln W, as in eqn 16.34. Further information 16.3 Temperatures below zero The Boltzmann distribution tells us that the ratio of populations in a two-level system at a temperature T is = e−ε/kT (16.54) where ε is the separation of the upper state N+ and the lower state N−. It follows that, if we can contrive the population of the upper state to exceed that of the lower state, then the temperature must have a negative value. Indeed, for a general population, T = (16.55) and the temperature is formally negative for all N+ > N−. All the statistical thermodynamic expressions we have derived apply to T < 0 as well as to T > 0, the difference being that states with T < 0 are not in thermal equilibrium and therefore have to be achieved by techniques that do not rely on the equalization of temperatures of the system and its surroundings. The Third Law of thermodynamics prohibits the achievement of absolute zero in a finite number of steps. However, it is possible to circumvent this restriction in systems that have a finite number of levels or in systems that are effectively finite because they have such weak coupling to their surroundings. The practical realization of such a system is a group of spin-1 –2 nuclei that have very long relaxation times, such as the 19 F nuclei in cold solid LiF. Pulse techniques in NMR can achieve non-equilibrium populations (Section 15.8) as can pumping procedures in laser technologies (Section 14.5). From now on, we shall suppose that these non-equilibrium distributions have been achieved, and will concentrate on the consequences. The expressions for q, U, and S that we have derived in this chapter are applicable to T < 0 as well as to T > 0, and are shown in Fig. 16.19. We see that q and U show sharp discontinuities on passing through zero, and T = +0 (corresponding to all population in the lower state) is quite distinct from T = −0, where all the population is in the upper state. The entropy S is continuous at T = 0. But all these functions are continuous if we use β = 1/kT as the dependent variable (Fig. 16.20), which shows that β is a more natural, if less familiar, variable than T. Note that U → 0 as β → ∞ (that is, as T → 0, when only the lower state is occupied) and U → Nε as β → −∞ (that is, as T → −0); ε/k ln(N−/N+) N+ N− D E F ∂ lnW ∂ni A B C D E F ∂ lnW ∂ni A B C we see that a state with T = −0 is ‘hotter’ than one with T = +0. The entropy of the system is zero on either side of T = 0, and rises to Nk ln 2 as T → ±∞. At T = +0 only one state is accessible (the lower state), only the upper state is accessible, so the entropy is zero in each case. We get more insight into the dependence of thermodynamic properties on temperature by noting the thermodynamic result (Section 3.8) that T = (∂S/∂U)T. When S is plotted against U for a two-level system (Fig. 6.21), we see that the entropy rises as energy is supplied to the system (as we would expect) provided that T > 0 (the thermal equilibrium regime). However, the entropy decreases as energy is supplied when T < 0. This conclusion is consistent with the thermodynamic definition of entropy, dS = dqrev/T (where, of course, q denotes heat and not the partition function). Physically, the increase in entropy for T > 0 corresponds to the increasing accessibility of the upper state, and the decrease for T < 0 corresponds Internalenergy,/UN 0.5 1 Entropy.,/SNk 0.5 1 Partitionfunction,q 0-5-10 kT/ 5 10 6 2 4 0-5-10 kT/ 5 10 0-5-10 kT/ 5 10 e e e e Fig. 16.19 The partition function, internal energy, and entropy of a two-level system extended to negative temperatures. DISCUSSION QUESTIONS 585 to the shift towards population of the upper state alone as more energy is packed into the system. The phenomenological laws of thermodynamics survive largely intact at negative temperatures. The First Law (in essence, the conservation of energy) is robust, and independent of how populations are distributed over states. The Second Law survives because the definition of entropy survives (as we have seen above). The efficiency of heat engines (Section 3.2), which is a direct consequence of the Second Law, is still given by 1 − Tcold/Thot. However, if the temperature of the cold reservoir is negative, then the efficiency of the engine may be greater than 1. This condition corresponds to the amplification of signals achieved in lasers. Alternatively, an efficiency greater than 1 implies that heat can be converted completely into work provided the heat is withdrawn from a reservoir at T < 0. If both reservoirs are at negative temperatures, then the efficiency is less than 1, as in the thermal equilibrium case treated in Chapter 3. The Third Law requires a slight amendment on account of the discontinuity of the populations across T = 0: it is impossible in a finite number of steps to cool any system down to +0 or to heat any system above −0. Internalenergy,/UN 0.5 1 Entropy.,/SNk 0.5 1 Partitionfunction,q 0-5-10 /kT 5 10 6 2 4 0 0 -5 -5 -10 -10 /kT /kT 5 5 10 10 e e e e Fig. 16.20 The partition function, internal energy, and entropy of a two-level system extended to negative temperatures but plotted against β = 1/kT (modified here to the dimensionless quantity ε/kT). Internal energy, /U N Entropy,/SNk 0.5 1 0 0.5 1 e Fig. 16.21 The variation of the entropy with internal energy for a two-level system extended to negative temperatures. Discussion questions 16.1 Describe the physical significance of the partition function. 16.2 Explain how the internal energy and entropy of a system composed of two levels vary with temperature. 16.3 Enumerate the ways by which the parameter β may be identified with 1/kT. 16.4 Distinguish between the zipper and Zimm–Bragg models of the helix–coil transition. 16.5 Explain what is meant by an ensemble and why it is useful in statistical thermodynamics. 16.6 Under what circumstances may identical particles be regarded as distinguishable? 586 16 STATISTICAL THERMODYNAMICS 1: THE CONCEPTS Exercises 16.1a What are the relative populations of the states of a two-level system when the temperature is infinite? 16.1b What is the temperature of a two-level system of energy separation equivalent to 300 cm−1 when the population of the upper state is one-half that of the lower state? 16.2a Calculate the translational partition function at (a) 300 K and (b) 600 K of a molecule of molar mass 120 g mol−1 in a container of volume 2.00 cm3 . 16.2b Calculate (a) the thermal wavelength, (b) the translational partition function of an Ar atom in a cubic box of side 1.00 cm at (i) 300 K and (ii) 3000 K. 16.3a Calculate the ratio of the translational partition functions of D2 and H2 at the same temperature and volume. 16.3b Calculate the ratio of the translational partition functions of xenon and helium at the same temperature and volume. 16.4a A certain atom has a threefold degenerate ground level, a nondegenerate electronically excited level at 3500 cm−1 , and a threefold degenerate level at 4700 cm−1 . Calculate the partition function of these electronic states at 1900 K. 16.4b A certain atom has a doubly degenerate ground level, a triply degenerate electronically excited level at 1250 cm−1 , and a doubly degenerate level at 1300 cm−1 . Calculate the partition function of these electronic states at 2000 K. 16.5a Calculate the electronic contribution to the molar internal energy at 1900 K for a sample composed of the atoms specified in Exercise 16.4a. 16.5b Calculate the electronic contribution to the molar internal energy at 2000 K for a sample composed of the atoms specified in Exercise 16.4b. 16.6a A certain molecule has a non-degenerate excited state lying at 540 cm−1 above the non-degenerate ground state. At what temperature will 10 per cent of the molecules be in the upper state? 16.6b A certain molecule has a doubly degenerate excited state lying at 360 cm−1 above the non-degenerate ground state. At what temperature will 15 per cent of the molecules be in the upper state? 16.7a An electron spin can adopt either of two orientations in a magnetic field, and its energies are ±µBB, where µB is the Bohr magneton. Deduce an expression for the partition function and mean energy of the electron and sketch the variation of the functions with B. Calculate the relative populations of the spin states at (a) 4.0 K, (b) 298 K when B = 1.0 T. 16.7b A nitrogen nucleus spin can adopt any of three orientations in a magnetic field, and its energies are 0, ±γN$B, where γN is the magnetogyric ratio of the nucleus. Deduce an expression for the partition function and mean energy of the nucleus and sketch the variation of the functions with B. Calculate the relative populations of the spin states at (a) 1.0 K, (b) 298 K when B = 20.0 T. 16.8a Consider a system of distinguishable particles having only two nondegenerate energy levels separated by an energy that is equal to the value of kT at 10 K. Calculate (a) the ratio of populations in the two states at (1) 1.0 K, (2) 10 K, and (3) 100 K, (b) the molecular partition function at 10 K, (c) the molar energy at 10 K, (d) the molar heat capacity at 10 K, (e) the molar entropy at 10 K. 16.8b Consider a system of distinguishable particles having only three nondegenerate energy levels separated by an energy which is equal to the value of kT at 25.0 K. Calculate (a) the ratio of populations in the states at (1) 1.00 K, (2) 25.0 K, and (3) 100 K, (b) the molecular partition function at 25.0 K, (c) the molar energy at 25.0 K, (d) the molar heat capacity at 25.0 K, (e) the molar entropy at 25.0 K. 16.9a At what temperature would the population of the first excited vibrational state of HCl be 1/e times its population of the ground state? 16.9b At what temperature would the population of the first excited rotational level of HCl be 1/e times its population of the ground state? 16.10a Calculate the standard molar entropy of neon gas at (a) 200 K, (b) 298.15 K. 16.10b Calculate the standard molar entropy of xenon gas at (a) 100 K, (b) 298.15 K. 16.11a Calculate the vibrational contribution to the entropy of Cl2 at 500 K given that the wavenumber of the vibration is 560 cm−1 . 16.11b Calculate the vibrational contribution to the entropy of Br2 at 600 K given that the wavenumber of the vibration is 321 cm−1 . 16.12a Identify the systems for which it is essential to include a factor of 1/N! on going from Q to q: (a) a sample of helium gas, (b) a sample of carbon monoxide gas, (c) a solid sample of carbon monoxide, (d) water vapour. 16.12b Identify the systems for which it is essential to include a factor of 1/N! on going from Q to q: (a) a sample of carbon dioxide gas, (b) a sample of graphite, (c) a sample of diamond, (d) ice. Problems* Numerical problems 16.1‡ Consider a system A consisting of subsystems A1 and A2, for which W1 = 1 × 1020 and W2 = 2 × 1020 . What is the number of configurations available to the combined system? Also, compute the entropies S, S1, and S2. What is the significance of this result? 16.2‡ Consider 1.00 × 1022 4 He atoms in a box of dimensions 1.0 cm × 1.0 cm × 1.0 cm. Calculate the occupancy of the first excited level at 1.0 mK, 2.0 K, and 4.0 K. Do the same for 3 He. What conclusions might you draw from the results of your calculations? * Problems denoted with the symbol ‡ were supplied by Charles Trapp and Carmen Giunta. PROBLEMS 587 16.3‡ By what factor does the number of available configurations increase when 100 J of energy is added to a system containing 1.00 mol of particles at constant volume at 298 K? 16.4‡ By what factor does the number of available configurations increase when 20 m3 of air at 1.00 atm and 300 K is allowed to expand by 0.0010 per cent at constant temperature? 16.5 Explore the conditions under which the ‘integral’ approximation for the translational partition function is not valid by considering the translational partition function of an Ar atom in a cubic box of side 1.00 cm. Estimate the temperature at which, according to the integral approximation, q = 10 and evaluate the exact partition function at that temperature. 16.6 A certain atom has a doubly degenerate ground level pair and an upper level of four degenerate states at 450 cm−1 above the ground level. In an atomic beam study of the atoms it was observed that 30 per cent of the atoms were in the upper level, and the translational temperature of the beam was 300 K. Are the electronic states of the atoms in thermal equilibrium with the translational states? 16.7 (a) Calculate the electronic partition function of a tellurium atom at (i) 298 K, (ii) 5000 K by direct summation using the following data: Term Degeneracy Wavenumber/cm−1 Ground 5 0 1 1 4 707 2 3 4 751 3 5 10 559 (b) What proportion of the Te atoms are in the ground term and in the term labelled 2 at the two temperatures? (c) Calculate the electronic contribution to the standard molar entropy of gaseous Te atoms. 16.8 The four lowest electronic levels of a Ti atom are: 3 F2, 3 F3, 3 F4, and 5 F1, at 0, 170, 387, and 6557 cm−1 , respectively. There are many other electronic states at higher energies. The boiling point of titanium is 3287°C. What are the relative populations of these levels at the boiling point? Hint. The degeneracies of the levels are 2J + 1. 16.9 The NO molecule has a doubly degenerate excited electronic level 121.1 cm−1 above the doubly degenerate electronic ground term. Calculate and plot the electronic partition function of NO from T = 0 to 1000 K. Evaluate (a) the term populations and (b) the electronic contribution to the molar internal energy at 300 K. Calculate the electronic contribution to the molar entropy of the NO molecule at 300 K and 500 K. 16.10‡ J. Sugar and A. Musgrove (J. Phys. Chem. Ref. Data 22, 1213 (1993)) have published tables of energy levels for germanium atoms and cations from Ge+ to Ge+31 . The lowest-lying energy levels in neutral Ge are as follows: 3 P0 3 P1 3 P2 1 D2 1 S0 E/cm−1 0 557.1 1410.0 7125.3 16 367.3 Calculate the electronic partition function at 298 K and 1000 K by direct summation. Hint. The degeneracy of a level is 2J + 1. 16.11 Calculate, by explicit summation, the vibrational partition function and the vibrational contribution to the molar internal energy of I2 molecules at (a) 100 K, (b) 298 K given that its vibrational energy levels lie at the following wavenumbers above the zero-point energy level: 0, 213.30, 425.39, 636.27, 845.93 cm−1 . What proportion of I2 molecules are in the ground and first two excited levels at the two temperatures? Calculate the vibrational contribution to the molar entropy of I2 at the two temperatures. 16.12‡ (a) The standard molar entropy of graphite at 298, 410, and 498 K is 5.69, 9.03, and 11.63 J K−1 mol−1 , respectively. If 1.00 mol C(graphite) at 298 K is surrounded by thermal insulation and placed next to 1.00 mol C(graphite) at 498 K, also insulated, how many configurations are there altogether for the combined but independent systems? (b) If the same two samples are now placed in thermal contact and brought to thermal equilibrium, the final temperature will be 410 K. (Why might the final temperature not be the average?) How many configurations are there now in the combined system? Neglect any volume changes. (c) Demonstrate that this process is spontaneous. Theoretical problems 16.13 A sample consisting of five molecules has a total energy 5ε. Each molecule is able to occupy states of energy jε, with j = 0, 1, 2, . . . . (a) Calculate the weight of the configuration in which the molecules are distributed evenly over the available states. (b) Draw up a table with columns headed by the energy of the states and write beneath them all configurations that are consistent with the total energy. Calculate the weights of each configuration and identify the most probable configurations. 16.14 A sample of nine molecules is numerically tractable but on the verge of being thermodynamically significant. Draw up a table of configurations for N = 9, total energy 9ε in a system with energy levels jε (as in Problem 16.13). Before evaluating the weights of the configurations, guess (by looking for the most ‘exponential’ distribution of populations) which of the configurations will turn out to be the most probable. Go on to calculate the weights and identify the most probable configuration. 16.15 The most probable configuration is characterized by a parameter we know as the ‘temperature’. The temperatures of the system specified in Problems 16.13 and 16.14 must be such as to give a mean value of ε for the energy of each molecule and a total energy Nε for the system. (a) Show that the temperature can be obtained by plotting pj against j, where pj is the (most probable) fraction of molecules in the state with energy jε. Apply the procedure to the system in Problem 16.14. What is the temperature of the system when ε corresponds to 50 cm−1 ? (b) Choose configurations other than the most probable, and show that the same procedure gives a worse straight line, indicating that a temperature is not well-defined for them. 16.16 A certain molecule can exist in either a non-degenerate singlet state or a triplet state (with degeneracy 3). The energy of the triplet exceeds that of the singlet by ε. Assuming that the molecules are distinguishable (localized) and independent, (a) obtain the expression for the molecular partition function. (b) Find expressions in terms of ε for the molar energy, molar heat capacity, and molar entropy of such molecules and calculate their values at T = ε/k. 16.17 Consider a system with energy levels εj = jε and N molecules. (a) Show that if the mean energy per molecule is aε, then the temperature is given by β = ln l + Evaluate the temperature for a system in which the mean energy is ε, taking ε equivalent to 50 cm−1 . (b) Calculate the molecular partition function q for the system when its mean energy is aε. (c) Show that the entropy of the system is S/k = (1 + a) ln(1 + a) − a ln a and evaluate this expression for a mean energy ε. 16.18 Consider Stirling’s approximation for ln N! in the derivation of the Boltzmann distribution. What difference would it make if (a) a cruder approximation, N! = NN , (b) the better approximation in Comment 16.2 were used instead? 16.19‡ For gases, the canonical partition function, Q, is related to the molecular partition function q by Q = qN /N!. Use the expression for q and general thermodynamic relations to derive the perfect gas law pV = nRT. D E F 1 a A B C 1 ε 588 16 STATISTICAL THERMODYNAMICS 1: THE CONCEPTS Applications: to atmospheric science, astrophysics, and biochemistry 16.20‡ Obtain the barometric formula (Problem 1.27) from the Boltzmann distribution. Recall that the potential energy of a particle at height h above the surface of the Earth is mgh. Convert the barometric formula from pressure to number density, N . Compare the relative number densities, N (h)/N (0), for O2 and H2O at h = 8.0 km, a typical cruising altitude for commercial aircraft. 16.21‡ Planets lose their atmospheres over time unless they are replenished. A complete analysis of the overall process is very complicated and depends upon the radius of the planet, temperature, atmospheric composition, and other factors. Prove that the atmosphere of planets cannot be in an equilibrium state by demonstrating that the Boltzmann distribution leads to a uniform finite number density as r → ∞. Hint. Recall that in a gravitational field the potential energy is V(r) = −GMm/r, where G is the gravitational constant, M is the mass of the planet, and m the mass of the particle. 16.22‡ Consider the electronic partition function of a perfect atomic hydrogen gas at a density of 1.99 × 10−4 kg m−3 and 5780 K. These are the mean conditions within the Sun’s photosphere, the surface layer of the Sun that is about 190 km thick. (a) Show that this partition function, which involves a sum over an infinite number of quantum states that are solutions to the Schrödinger equation for an isolated atomic hydrogen atom, is infinite. (b) Develop a theoretical argument for truncating the sum and estimate the maximum number of quantum states that contribute to the sum. (c) Calculate the equilibrium probability that an atomic hydrogen electron is in each quantum state. Are there any general implications concerning electronic states that will be observed for other atoms and molecules? Is it wise to apply these calculations in the study of the Sun’s photosphere? 16.23 Consider a protein P with four distinct sites, with each site capable of binding one ligand L. Show that the possible varieties (configurations) of the species PLi (with PL0 denoting P) are given by the binomial coefficients C(4,i). 16.24 Complete some of the derivations in the discussion of the helix–coil transition in polypeptides (Impact I16.1). (a) Show that, within the tenets of the zipper model, q = 1 + n ∑i=1 Z(n,i)σsi and that Z(n,i) = n − i + 1 is the number of ways in which an allowed state with a number i of c amino acids can be formed. (b) Using the zipper model, show that θ = (1/n)d(ln q)/d(ln s). Hint. As a first step, show that ∑ii(n − i + 1)σsi = s(dq/ds). 16.25 Here you will use the zipper model discussed in Impact I16.1 to explore the helix–coil transition in polypeptides.(a) Investigate the effect of the parameter s on the distribution of random coil segments in a polypeptide with n = 20 by plotting pi, the fraction of molecules with a number i of amino acids in a coil region, against i for s = 0.8, 1.0, and 1.5, with σ = 5.0 × 10−2 . Discuss the significance of any effects you discover. (b) The average value of i given by ͗i͘ = ∑iipi. Use the results of the zipper model to calculate ͗i͘ for all the combinations of s and σ used in Fig. 16.10 and part (a). Statistical thermodynamics 2: applications In this chapter we apply the concepts of statistical thermodynamics to the calculation of chemically significant quantities. First, we establish the relations between thermodynamic functions and partition functions. Next, we show that the molecular partition function can be factorized into contributions from each mode of motion and establish the formulas for the partition functions for translational, rotational, and vibrational modes of motion and the contribution of electronic excitation. These contributions can be calculated from spectroscopic data. Finally, we turn to specific applications, which include the mean energies of modes of motion, the heat capacities of substances, and residual entropies. In the final section, we see how to calculate the equilibrium constant of a reaction and through that calculation understand some of the molecular features that determine the magnitudes of equilibrium constants and their variation with temperature. A partition function is the bridge between thermodynamics, spectroscopy, and quantum mechanics. Once it is known, a partition function can be used to calculate thermodynamic functions, heat capacities, entropies, and equilibrium constants. It also sheds light on the significance of these properties. Fundamental relations In this section we see how to obtain any thermodynamic function once we know the partition function. Then we see how to calculate the molecular partition function, and through that the thermodynamic functions, from spectroscopic data. 17.1 The thermodynamic functions We have already derived (in Chapter 16) the two expressions for calculating the internal energy and the entropy of a system from its canonical partition function, Q: U − U(0) = − V S = + klnQ (17.1) where β = 1/kT. If the molecules are independent, we can go on to make the substitutions Q = qN (for distinguishable molecules, as in a solid) or Q = qN /N! (for indistinguishable molecules, as in a gas). All the thermodynamic functions introduced in Part 1 are related to U and S, so we have a route to their calculation from Q. U − U(0) T D F ∂ ln Q ∂β A C 17 Fundamental relations 17.1 The thermodynamic functions 17.2 The molecular partition function Using statistical thermodynamics 17.3 Mean energies 17.4 Heat capacities 17.5 Equations of state 17.6 Molecular interactions in liquids 17.7 Residual entropies 17.8 Equilibrium constants Checklist of key ideas Further reading Discussion questions Exercises Problems 590 17 STATISTICAL THERMODYNAMICS 2: APPLICATIONS (a) The Helmholtz energy The Helmholtz energy, A, is defined as A = U − TS. This relation implies that A(0) = U(0), so substitution for U and S by using eqn 17.1 leads to the very simple expression A − A(0) = −kT ln Q (17.2) (b) The pressure By an argument like that leading to eqn 3.31, it follows from A = U − TS that dA = −pdV − SdT. Therefore, on imposing constant temperature, the pressure and the Helmholtz energy are related by p = −(∂A/∂V)T. It then follows from eqn 17.2 that p = kT T (17.3) This relation is entirely general, and may be used for any type of substance, including perfect gases, real gases, and liquids. Because Q is in general a function of the volume, temperature, and amount of substance, eqn 17.3 is an equation of state. Example 17.1 Deriving an equation of state Derive an expression for the pressure of a gas of independent particles. Method We should suspect that the pressure is that given by the perfect gas law. To proceed systematically, substitute the explicit formula for Q for a gas of independent, indistinguishable molecules (see eqn 16.45 and Table 17.3 at the end of the chapter) into eqn 17.3. Answer For a gas of independent molecules, Q = qN /N! with q = V/Λ3 : p = kT T = T = T = × = = To derive this relation, we have used T = T = and NkT = nNAkT = nRT. The calculation shows that the equation of state of a gas of independent particles is indeed the perfect gas law. Self-test 17.1 Derive the equation of state of a sample for which Q = qN f/N!, with q = V/Λ3 , where f depends on the volume. [p = nRT/V + kT(∂ ln f/∂V)T] (c) The enthalpy At this stage we can use the expressions for U and p in the definition H = U + pV to obtain an expression for the enthalpy, H, of any substance: H − H(0) = − V + kTV T (17.4) D F ∂ ln Q ∂V A C D F ∂ ln Q ∂β A C 1 Λ3 D F ∂(V/Λ3 ) ∂V A C D F ∂q ∂V A C nRT V NkT V 1 Λ3 NkTΛ3 V D F ∂q ∂V A C NkT q D F ∂Q ∂V A C kT Q D F ∂ ln Q ∂V A C D F ∂ ln Q ∂V A C 17.2 THE MOLECULAR PARTITION FUNCTION 591 We have already seen that U − U(0) = 3 –2nRT for a gas of independent particles (eqn 16.32a), and have just shown that pV = nRT. Therefore, for such a gas, H − H(0) = 5 –2nRT (17.5)° (d) The Gibbs energy One of the most important thermodynamic functions for chemistry is the Gibbs energy, G = H − TS = A + pV. We can now express this function in terms of the partition function by combining the expressions for A and p: G − G(0) = −kT ln Q + kTV T (17.6) This expression takes a simple form for a gas of independent molecules because pV in the expression G = A + pV can be replaced by nRT: G − G(0) = −kT ln Q + nRT (17.7)° Furthermore, because Q = qN /N!, and therefore ln Q = N ln q − ln N!, it follows by using Stirling’s approximation (ln N! ≈ N ln N −N) that we can write G − G(0) = −NkT ln q + kT ln N! + nRT = −nRT ln q + kT(N ln N − N) + nRT = −nRT ln (17.8)° with N = nNA. Now we see another interpretation of the Gibbs energy: it is proportional to the logarithm of the average number of thermally accessible states per molecule. It will turn out to be convenient to define the molar partition function, qm = q/n (with units mol−1 ), for then G − G(0) = −nRT ln (17.9)° 17.2 The molecular partition function The energy of a molecule is the sum of contributions from its different modes of motion: εi = εi T + εi R + εi V + εi E (17.10) where T denotes translation, R rotation, V vibration, and E the electronic contribution. The electronic contribution is not actually a ‘mode of motion’, but it is convenient to include it here. The separation of terms in eqn 17.10 is only approximate (except for translation) because the modes are not completely independent, but in most cases it is satisfactory. The separation of the electronic and vibrational motions is justified provided only the ground electronic state is occupied (for otherwise the vibrational characteristics depend on the electronic state) and, for the electronic ground state, that the Born–Oppenheimer approximation is valid (Chapter 11). The separation of the vibrational and rotational modes is justified to the extent that the rotational constant is independent of the vibrational state. Given that the energy is a sum of independent contributions, the partition function factorizes into a product of contributions (recall Section 16.2b): qm NA q N D F ∂ ln Q ∂V A C 592 17 STATISTICAL THERMODYNAMICS 2: APPLICATIONS 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 100 0 1 2 3 4 J Contribution Fig. 17.1 The contributions to the rotational partition function of an HCl molecule at 25°C. The vertical axis is the value of (2J + 1)e−βhcBJ(J+1) . Successive terms (which are proportional to the populations of the levels) pass through a maximum because the population of individual states decreases exponentially, but the degeneracy of the levels increases with J. q = ∑ i e−βεi = ∑ i (all states) e−βεT i −βεR i −βεV i−βεE i = ∑ i (translational) ∑ i (rotational) ∑ i (vibrational) ∑ i (electronic) e−βεT i −βεR i −βεV i−βεE i (17.11) = ∑ i (translational) e−βεT i ∑ i (rotational) e−βεR i ∑ i (vibrational) e−βεV i ∑ i (electronic) e−βεE i = qT qR qV qE This factorization means that we can investigate each contribution separately. (a) The translational contribution The translational partition function of a molecule of mass m in a container of volume V was derived in Section 16.2: qT = Λ = h 1/2 = (17.12) Notice that qT → ∞ as T → ∞ because an infinite number of states becomes accessible as the temperature is raised. Even at room temperature qT ≈ 2 × 1028 for an O2 molecule in a vessel of volume 100 cm3 . The thermal wavelength, Λ, lets us judge whether the approximations that led to the expression for qT are valid. The approximations are valid if many states are occupied, which requires V/Λ3 to be large. That will be so if Λ is small compared with the linear dimensions of the container. For H2 at 25°C, Λ = 71 pm, which is far smaller than any conventional container is likely to be (but comparable to pores in zeolites or cavities in clathrates). For O2, a heavier molecule, Λ = 18 pm. We saw in Section 16.2 that an equivalent criterion of validity is that Λ should be much less than the average separation of the molecules in the sample. (b) The rotational contribution As demonstrated in Example 16.1, the partition function of a nonsymmetrical (AB) linear rotor is qR = ∑ J (2J + 1)e−βhcBJ(J+1) (17.13) The direct method of calculating qR is to substitute the experimental values of the rotational energy levels into this expression and to sum the series numerically. Example 17.2 Evaluating the rotational partition function explicitly Evaluate the rotational partition function of 1 H35 Cl at 25°C, given that B = 10.591 cm−1 . Method We use eqn 17.13 and evaluate it term by term. A useful relation is kT/hc = 207.22cm−1 at298.15K.Thesumisreadilyevaluatedbyusingmathematicalsoftware. Answer To show how successive terms contribute, we draw up the following table by using kT/hcB = 0.051 11 (Fig. 17.1): J 0 1 2 3 4 . . . 10 (2J + 1)e−0.0511J(J+1) 1 2.71 3.68 3.79 3.24 . . . 0.08 h (2πmkT)1/2 D F β 2πm A C V Λ3 D F A C D F A C D F A C D F A C 17.2 THE MOLECULAR PARTITION FUNCTION 593 The sum required by eqn 17.13 (the sum of the numbers in the second row of the table) is 19.9, hence qR = 19.9 at this temperature. Taking J up to 50 gives qR = 19.902. Notice that about ten J-levels are significantly populated but the number of populated states is larger on account of the (2J + 1)-fold degeneracy of each level. We shall shortly encounter the approximation that qR ≈ kT/hcB, which in the present case gives qR = 19.6, in good agreement with the exact value and with much less work. Self-test 17.2 Evaluate the rotational partition function for HCl at 0°C. [18.26] At room temperature kT/hc ≈ 200 cm−1 . The rotational constants of many molecules are close to 1 cm−1 (Table 13.2) and often smaller (though the very light H2 molecule, for which B = 60.9 cm−1 , is one exception). It follows that many rotational levels are populated at normal temperatures. When this is the case, the partition function may be approximated by Linear rotors: qR = (17.14a) Nonlinear rotors: qR = 3/2 1/2 (17.14b) where A, B, and C are the rotational constants of the molecule. However, before using these expressions, read on (to eqns 17.15 and 17.16). Justification 17.1 The rotational contribution to the molecular partition function When many rotational states are occupied and kT is much larger than the separation between neighbouring states, the sum in the partition function can be approximated by an integral, much as we did for translational motion in Justification 16.2: qR = Ύ ∞ 0 (2J + 1)e−βhcBJ(J+1) dJ Although this integral looks complicated, it can be evaluated without much effort by noticing that because eaJ(J+1) = aJ(J + 1) eaJ(J+1) = a(2J + 1)eaJ(J+1) it can also be written as qR = Ύ ∞ 0 e−βhcBJ(J+1) dJ Then, because the integral of a derivative of a function is the function itself, we obtain qR = − e−βhcBJ(J+1) 0 ∞ = which (because β = 1/kT) is eqn 17.14a. The calculation for a nonlinear molecule is along the same lines, but slightly trickier. First, we note that the energies of a symmetric rotor are EJ,K,MJ = hcBJ(J + 1) + hc(A − B)K2 1 βhcB 1 βhcB D E F d dJ A B C 1 βhcB 5 6 7 d dJ 1 2 3 d dJ D F π ABC A C D F kT hc A C kT hcB 594 17 STATISTICAL THERMODYNAMICS 2: APPLICATIONS with J = 0, 1, 2, . . . , K = J, J − 1, . . . , −J, and MJ = J, J − 1, . . . , −J. Instead of considering these ranges, we can cover the same values by allowing K to range from −∞ to ∞, with J confined to |K|, |K| + 1, . . . , ∞ for each value of K (Fig. 17.2). Because the energy is independent of MJ, and there are 2J + 1 values of MJ for each value of J, each value of J is 2J + 1-fold degenerate. It follows that the partition function q = ∞ ∑ J=0 J ∑ K=−J J ∑ MJ=−J e−EJKMJ /kT can be written equivalently as q = ∞ ∑ K=−∞ ∞ ∑ J=|K| (2J + 1)e−EJKMJ /kT = ∞ ∑ K=−∞ ∞ ∑ J=|K| (2J + 1)e−hc{BJ(J+1)+(A−B)K2 }/kT = ∞ ∑ K=−∞ e−{hc(A−B)/kT}K2 ∞ ∑ J=|K| (2J + 1)e−hcBJ(J+1)/kT Now we assume that the temperature is so high that numerous states are occupied and that the sums may be approximated by integrals. Then q = Ύ ∞ −∞ e−{hc(A−B)/kT}K2 Ύ ∞ |K| (2J + 1)e−hcBJ(J+1)/kT dJdK As before, the integral over J can be recognized as the integral of the derivative of a function, which is the function itself, so Ύ ∞ |K| (2J + 1)e−hcBJ(J+1)/kT dJ = Ύ ∞ |K| − e−hcBJ(J+1)/kT dJ = − e−hcBJ(J+1)/kT ∞ |K| = e−hcB|K|(|K|+1)/kT ≈ e−hcBK2 /kT In the last line we have supposed that |K| >> 1 for most contributions. Now we can write q = Ύ ∞ −∞ e−{hc(A−B)/kT}K2 e−hcBK2 /kT dK π1/2 = Ύ ∞ −∞ e−{hcA/kT}K2 dK = 1/2 Ύ ∞ −∞ e−x2 dx = 3/2 1/2 For an asymmetric rotor, one of the Bs is replaced by C, to give eqn 17.14b. A useful way of expressing the temperature above which the rotational approximation is valid is to introduce the characteristic rotational temperature, θR = hcB/k. Then ‘high temperature’ means T >> θR and under these conditions the rotational partition function of a linear molecule is simply T/θR. Some typical values of θR are shown in Table 17.1. The value for H2 is abnormally high and we must be careful with the approximation for this molecule. D E F π AB2 A B C D E F kT hc A B C D E F kT hcA A B C D E F kT hcB A B C kT hcB 5 6 7 kT hcB D E F kT hcB A B C D E F kT hcB A B C D E F kT hcB A B C d dJ D E F kT hcB A B C Synoptic table 17.1* Rotational and vibrational temperatures Molecule Mode qV/K qR/K H2 6330 88 HCl 4300 9.4 I2 309 0.053 CO2 ν1 1997 0.561 ν2 3380 ν3 960 * For more values, see Table 13.2 in the Data section and use hc/k = 1.439 K cm. J 0 1 2 3 4 5 K J= - K J= + 0 +1 +2 +3 +4 +5-1-2-3-4-5 J 0 1 2 3 4 5 J K= | | J K= | | KJ0,0,1,2,...== KJ1,1,2,3,...=+= KJ2,2,3,4,...=+= KJ1,1,2,3,...=-= KJ2,2,3,4,...=-= K = (a) (b) Fig. 17.2 (a) The sum over J = 0, 1, 2, . . . and K = J, J − 1, . . . , −J (depicted by the circles) can be covered (b) by allowing K to range from −∞ to ∞, with J confined to |K|, |K| + 1, . . . , ∞ for each value of K. 17.2 THE MOLECULAR PARTITION FUNCTION 595 The general conclusion at this stage is that molecules with large moments of inertia (and hence small rotational constants and low characteristic rotational temperatures) have large rotational partition functions. The large value of qR reflects the closeness in energy (compared with kT) of the rotational levels in large, heavy molecules, and the large number of them that are accessible at normal temperatures. We must take care, however, not to include too many rotational states in the sum. For a homonuclear diatomic molecule or a symmetrical linear molecule (such as CO2 or HC.CH), a rotation through 180° results in an indistinguishable state of the molecule. Hence, the number of thermally accessible states is only half the number that can be occupied by a heteronuclear diatomic molecule, where rotation through 180° does result in a distinguishable state. Therefore, for a symmetrical linear molecule, qR = = (17.15a) The equations for symmetrical and nonsymmetrical molecules can be combined into a single expression by introducing the symmetry number, σ, which is the number of indistinguishable orientations of the molecule. Then qR = = (17.15b) For a heteronuclear diatomic molecule σ = 1; for a homonuclear diatomic molecule or a symmetrical linear molecule, σ = 2. Justification 17.2 The origin of the symmetry number The quantum mechanical origin of the symmetry number is the Pauli principle, which forbids the occupation of certain states. We saw in Section 13.8, for example, that H2 may occupy rotational states with even J only if its nuclear spins are paired (para-hydrogen), and odd J states only if its nuclear spins are parallel (orthohydrogen). There are three states of ortho-H2 to each value of J (because there are three parallel spin states of the two nuclei). To set up the rotational partition function we note that ‘ordinary’ molecular hydrogen is a mixture of one part para-H2 (with only its even-J rotational states occupied) and three parts ortho-H2 (with only its odd-J rotational states occupied). Therefore, the average partition function per molecule is qR = 1–4 ∑ even J (2J + 1)e−βhcBJ(J+1) + 3–4 ∑ odd J (2J + 1)e−βhcBJ(J+1) The odd-J states are more heavily weighted than the even-J states (Fig. 17.3). From the illustration we see that we would obtain approximately the same answer for the partition function (the sum of all the populations) if each J term contributed half its normal value to the sum. That is, the last equation can be approximated as qR = 1–2 ∑ J (2J + 1)e−βhcBJ(J+1) and this approximation is very good when many terms contribute (at high temperatures). The same type of argument may be used for linear symmetrical molecules in which identical bosons are interchanged by rotation (such as CO2). As pointed out in Section 13.8, if the nuclear spin of the bosons is 0, then only even-J states are admissible. Because only half the rotational states are occupied, the rotational partition function is only half the value of the sum obtained by allowing all values of J to contribute (Fig. 17.4). T σθR kT σhcB T 2θR kT 2hcB ortho-H2 para-H2 0 1 J Fig. 17.3 The values of the individual terms (2J + 1)e−βhcBJ(J+1) contributing to the mean partition function of a 3:1 mixture of ortho- and para-H2. The partition function is the sum of all these terms. At high temperatures, the sum is approximately equal to the sum of the terms over all values of J, each with a weight of 1 –2. This is the sum of the contributions indicated by the curve. 0 2 J Fig. 17.4 The relative populations of the rotational energy levels of CO2. Only states with even J values are occupied. The full line shows the smoothed, averaged population of levels. 596 17 STATISTICAL THERMODYNAMICS 2: APPLICATIONS Synoptic table 17.2* Symmetry numbers Molecule s H2O 2 NH3 3 CH4 12 C6H6 12 * For more values, see Table 13.2 in the Data section. N H H H 1 0 5 10 10 5 0 qV kT hc/ ~ 1 n Fig. 17.5 The vibrational partition function of a molecule in the harmonic approximation. Note that the partition function is linearly proportional to the temperature when the temperature is high (T >> θV). Exploration Plot the temperature dependence of the vibrational contribution to the molecular partition function for several values of the vibrational wavennumber. Estimate from your plots the temperature above which the harmonic oscillator is in the ‘high temperature’ limit. The same care must be exercised for other types of symmetrical molecule, and for a nonlinear molecule we write qR = 3/2 1/2 (17.16) Some typical values of the symmetry numbers required are given in Table 17.2. The value σ(H2O) = 2 reflects the fact that a 180° rotation about the bisector of the HO-H angle interchanges two indistinguishable atoms. In NH3, there are three indistinguishable orientations around the axis shown in (1). For CH4, any of three 120° rotations about any of its four C-H bonds leaves the molecule in an indistinguishable state, so the symmetry number is 3 × 4 = 12. For benzene, any of six orientations around the axis perpendicular to the plane of the molecule leaves it apparently unchanged, as does a rotation of 180° around any of six axes in the plane of the molecule (three of which pass along each C-H bond and the remaining three pass through each C-C bond in the plane of the molecule). For the way that group theory is used to identify the value of the symmetry number, see Problem 17.17. (c) The vibrational contribution The vibrational partition function of a molecule is calculated by substituting the measured vibrational energy levels into the exponentials appearing in the definition of qV , and summing them numerically. In a polyatomic molecule each normal mode (Section 13.14) has its own partition function (provided the anharmonicities are so small that the modes are independent). The overall vibrational partition function is the product of the individual partition functions, and we can write qV = qV (1)qV (2) . . . , where qV (K) is the partition function for the Kth normal mode and is calculated by direct summation of the observed spectroscopic levels. If the vibrational excitation is not too great, the harmonic approximation may be made, and the vibrational energy levels written as Ev = (v + 1 –2)hc# v = 0, 1, 2, . . . (17.17) If, as usual, we measure energies from the zero-point level, then the permitted values are εv = vhc# and the partition function is qV = ∑ v e−βvhc# = ∑ v (e−βhc# )v (17.18) (because eax = (ex )a ). We met this sum in Example 16.2 (which is no accident: the ladder-like array of levels in Fig. 16.3 is exactly the same as that of a harmonic oscillator). The series can be summed in the same way, and gives qV = (17.19) This function is plotted in Fig. 17.5. In a polyatomic molecule, each normal mode gives rise to a partition function of this form. Example 17.3 Calculating a vibrational partition function The wavenumbers of the three normal modes of H2O are 3656.7 cm−1 , 1594.8 cm−1 , and 3755.8 cm−1 . Evaluate the vibrational partition function at 1500 K. Method Use eqn 17.19 for each mode, and then form the product of the three contributions. At 1500 K, kT/hc = 1042.6 cm−1 . 1 1 − e−βhc# D F π ABC A C D F kT hc A C 1 σ 17.2 THE MOLECULAR PARTITION FUNCTION 597 Answer We draw up the following table displaying the contributions of each mode: Mode: 1 2 3 #/cm−1 3656.7 1594.8 3755.8 hc#/kT 3.507 1.530 3.602 qV 1.031 1.276 1.028 The overall vibrational partition function is therefore qV = 1.031 × 1.276 × 1.028 = 1.353 The three normal modes of H2O are at such high wavenumbers that even at 1500 K most of the molecules are in their vibrational ground state. However, there may be so many normal modes in a large molecule that their excitation may be significant even though each mode is not appreciably excited. For example, a nonlinear molecule containing 10 atoms has 3N − 6 = 24 normal modes (Section 13.14). If we assume a value of about 1.1 for the vibrational partition function of one normal mode, the overall vibrational partition function is about qV ≈ (1.1)24 = 9.8, which indicates significant vibrational excitation relative to a smaller molecule, such as H2O. Self-test 17.3 Repeat the calculation for CO2, where the vibrational wavenumbers are 1388 cm−1 , 667.4 cm−1 , and 2349 cm−1 , the second being the doubly degenerate bending mode. [6.79] In many molecules the vibrational wavenumbers are so great that βhc# > 1. For example, the lowest vibrational wavenumber of CH4 is 1306 cm−1 , so βhc# = 6.3 at room temperature. C-H stretches normally lie in the range 2850 to 2960 cm−1 , so for them βhc# ≈ 14. In these cases, e−βhc# in the denominator of qV is very close to zero (for example, e−6.3 = 0.002), and the vibrational partition function for a single mode is very close to 1 (qV = 1.002 when βhc# = 6.3), implying that only the zero-point level is significantly occupied. Now consider the case of bonds so weak that βhc# << kT. When this condition is satisfied, the partition function may be approximated by expanding the exponential (ex = 1 + x + · · ·): qV = (17.20) That is, for weak bonds at high temperatures, qV = = (17.21) The temperatures for which eqn 17.21 is valid can be expressed in terms of the characteristic vibrational temperature, θV = hc#/k (Table 17.1). The value for H2 is abnormally high because the atoms are so light and the vibrational frequency is correspondingly high. In terms of the vibrational temperature, ‘high temperature’ means T >> θV and, when this condition is satisfied, qV = T/θV (the analogue of the rotational expression). (d) The electronic contribution Electronic energy separations from the ground state are usually very large, so for most cases qE = 1. An important exception arises in the case of atoms and molecules having kT hc# 1 βhc# 1 1 − (1 − βhc# + · · ·) 598 17 STATISTICAL THERMODYNAMICS 2: APPLICATIONS electronically degenerate ground states, in which case qE = gE , where gE is the degeneracy of the electronic ground state. Alkali metal atoms, for example, have doubly degenerate ground states (corresponding to the two orientations of their electron spin), so qE = 2. Some atoms and molecules have low-lying electronically excited states. (At high enough temperatures, all atoms and molecules have thermally accessible excited states.) An example is NO, which has a configuration of the form . . . π1 (see Impact I11.1). The orbital angular momentum may take two orientations with respect to the molecular axis (corresponding to circulation clockwise or counter-clockwise around the axis), and the spin angular momentum may also take two orientations, giving four states in all (Fig. 17.6). The energy of the two states in which the orbital and spin momenta are parallel (giving the 2 Π3/2 term) is slightly greater than that of the two other states in which they are antiparallel (giving the 2 Π1/2 term). The separation, which arises from spin–orbit coupling (Section 10.8), is only 121 cm−1 . Hence, at normal temperatures, all four states are thermally accessible. If we denote the energies of the two levels as E1/2 = 0 and E3/2 = ε, the partition function is qE = ∑ energy levels gje−βεj = 2 + 2e−βε (17.22) Figure 17.7 shows the variation of this function with temperature. At T = 0, qE = 2, because only the doubly degenerate ground state is accessible. At high temperatures, qE approaches 4 because all four states are accessible. At 25°C, qE = 3.1. S S S S L L L L 2 P3/2 2 P1/2 121.1cm1Fig. 17.6 The doubly degenerate ground electronic level of NO (with the spin and orbital angular momentum around the axis in opposite directions) and the doubly degenerate first excited level (with the spin and orbital momenta parallel). The upper level is thermally accessible at room temperature. qE 4 2 0 5 10 3 kT/e Fig. 17.7 The variation with temperature of the electronic partition function of an NO molecule. Note that the curve resembles that for a two-level system (Fig.16.5), but rises from 2 (the degeneracy of the lower level) and approaches 4 (the total number of states) at high temperatures. Exploration Plot the temperature dependence of the electronic partition function for several values of the energy separation ε between two doubly degenerate levels. From your plots, estimate the temperature at which the population of the excited level begins to increase sharply. 17.3 MEAN ENERGIES 599 Comment 17.1 The text’s web site contains links to on-line databases of atomic and molecular spectra. (e) The overall partition function The partition functions for each mode of motion of a molecule are collected in Table 17.3 at the end of the chapter. The overall partition function is the product of each contribution. For a diatomic molecule with no low-lying electronically excited states and T >> θR, q = gE (17.23) Example 17.4 Calculating a thermodynamic function from spectroscopic data Calculate the value of G7 m − G7 m(0) for H2O(g) at 1500 K given that A = 27.8778 cm−1 , B = 14.5092 cm−1 , and C = 9.2869 cm−1 and the information in Example 17.3. Method The starting point is eqn 17.9. For the standard value, we evaluate the translational partition function at p7 (that is, at 105 Pa exactly). The vibrational partition function was calculated in Example 17.3. Use the expressions in Table 17.3 for the other contributions. Answer Because m = 18.015 u, it follows that qm T7 /NA = 1.706 × 108 . For the vibrational contribution we have already found that qV = 1.352. From Table 17.2 we see that σ = 2, so the rotational contribution is qR = 486.7. Therefore, G7 m − G7 m(0) = −(8.3145 J K−1 mol−1 ) × (1500 K) × ln{(1.706 × 108 ) × 486.7 × 1.352} = −317.3 kJ mol−1 Self-test 17.4 Repeat the calculation for CO2. The vibrational data are given in Self-test 17.3; B = 0.3902 cm−1 . [−366.6 kJ mol−1 ] Overall partition functions obtained from eqn 17.23 are approximate because they assume that the rotational levels are very close together and that the vibrational levels are harmonic. These approximations are avoided by using the energy levels identified spectroscopically and evaluating the sums explicitly. Using statistical thermodynamics We can now calculate any thermodynamic quantity from a knowledge of the energy levels of molecules: we have merged thermodynamics and spectroscopy. In this section, we indicate how to do the calculations for four important properties. 17.3 Mean energies It is often useful to know the mean energy, ͗ε͘, of various modes of motion. When the molecular partition function can be factorized into contributions from each mode, the mean energy of each mode M (from eqn 16.29) is ͗εM ͘ = − V M = T, R, V, or E (17.24) D F ∂qM ∂β A C 1 qM D F 1 1 − e−T/θv A C D F T σθR A C D F V Λ3 A C 600 17 STATISTICAL THERMODYNAMICS 2: APPLICATIONS (a) The mean translational energy To see a pattern emerging, we consider first a one-dimensional system of length X, for which qT = X/Λ, with Λ = h(β/2πm)1/2 . Then, if we note that Λ is a constant times β1/2 , ͗εT ͘ = − V = −β1/2 = = 1 –2kT (17.25a) For a molecule free to move in three dimensions, the analogous calculation leads to ͗εT ͘ = 3 –2kT (17.25b) Both conclusions are in agreement with the classical equipartition theorem (see Molecular interpretation 2.2) that the mean energy of each quadratic contribution to the energy is 1 –2kT. Furthermore, the fact that the mean energy is independent of the size of the container is consistent with the thermodynamic result that the internal energy of a perfect gas is independent of its volume (Molecular interpretation 2.2). (b) The mean rotational energy The mean rotational energy of a linear molecule is obtained from the partition function given in eqn 17.13. When the temperature is low (T < θR), the series must be summed term by term, which gives qR = 1 + 3e−2βhcB + 5e−6βhcB + · · · Hence ͗εR ͘ = (17.26a) This function is plotted in Fig. 17.8. At high temperatures (T >> θR), qR is given by eqn 17.15, and ͗εR ͘ = − = −σhcβB = = kT (17.26b) (qR is independent of V, so the partial derivatives have been replaced by complete derivatives.) The high-temperature result is also in agreement with the equipartition theorem, for the classical expression for the energy of a linear rotor is EK = 1 –2I⊥ωa 2 + 1 –2I⊥ωb 2 . (There is no rotation around the line of atoms.) It follows from the equipartition theorem that the mean rotational energy is 2 × 1 –2kT = kT. (c) The mean vibrational energy The vibrational partition function in the harmonic approximation is given in eqn 17.19. Because qV is independent of the volume, it follows that = = − (17.27) and hence from ͗εV ͘ = − = −(1 − e−βhc# ) − = that ͗εV ͘ = (17.28) hc# eβhc# − 1 hc#e−βhc# 1 − e−βhc# 5 6 7 hc#e−βhc# (1 − e−βhc# )2 1 2 3 dqV dβ 1 qV hc#e−βhc# (1 − e−βhc# )2 D F 1 1 − e−βhc# A C d dβ dqV dβ 1 β 1 σhcβB d dβ dqR dβ 1 qR hcB(6e−2βhcB + 30e−6βhcB + · · · ) 1 + 3e−2βhcB + 5e−6βhcB + · · · 1 2β D F 1 β1/2 A C d dβ D F X Λ ∂ ∂β A C Λ X 0 0 1 2 T/ R 0.5 1 1.5 áñ R /hcB q e Fig. 17.8 The mean rotational energy of a nonsymmetrical linear rotor as a function of temperature. At high temperatures (T >> θR), the energy is linearly proportional to the temperature, in accord with the equipartition theorem. Exploration Plot the temperature dependence of the mean rotational energy for several values of the rotational constant (for reasonable values of the rotational constant, see the Data section). From your plots, estimate the temperature at which the mean rotational energy begins to increase sharply. 17.4 HEAT CAPACITIES 601 The zero-point energy, 1 –2hc#, can be added to the right-hand side if the mean energy is to be measured from 0 rather than the lowest attainable level (the zero-point level). The variation of the mean energy with temperature is illustrated in Fig. 17.9. At high temperatures, when T >> θV, or βhc# << 1, the exponential functions can be expanded (ex = 1 + x + · · · ) and all but the leading terms discarded. This approximation leads to ͗εV ͘ = ≈ = kT (17.29) This result is in agreement with the value predicted by the classical equipartition theorem, because the energy of a one-dimensional oscillator is E = 1 –2mv2 x + 1 –2kx2 and the mean energy of each quadratic term is 1 –2kT. 17.4 Heat capacities The constant-volume heat capacity is defined as CV = (∂U/∂T)V. The derivative with respect to T is converted into a derivative with respect to β by using = = − = −kβ2 (17.30) It follows that CV = −kβ2 V (17.31a) Because the internal energy of a perfect gas is a sum of contributions, the heat capacity is also a sum of contributions from each mode. The contribution of mode M is CV M = N V = −Nkβ2 V (17.31b) (a) The individual contributions The temperature is always high enough (provided the gas is above its condensation temperature) for the mean translational energy to be 3 –2kT, the equipartition value. Therefore, the molar constant-volume heat capacity is CT V,m = NA = 3 –2R (17.32) Translation is the only mode of motion for a monatomic gas, so for such a gas CV,m = 3 –2R = 12.47 J K−1 mol−1 . This result is very reliable: helium, for example, has this value over a range of 2000 K. We saw in Section 2.5 that Cp,m − CV,m = R, so for a monatomic perfect gas Cp,m = 5 –2R, and therefore γ = = 5 –3 (17.33)° When the temperature is high enough for the rotations of the molecules to be highly excited (when T >> θR), we can use the equipartition value kT for the mean rotational energy (for a linear rotor) to obtain CV,m = R. For nonlinear molecules, the mean rotational energy rises to 3 –2kT, so the molar rotational heat capacity rises to 3 –2R when T >> θR. Only the lowest rotational state is occupied when the temperature is very low, and then rotation does not contribute to the heat capacity. We can Cp CV d(3 –2kT) dT D F ∂͗εM ͘ ∂β A C D F ∂͗εM ͘ ∂T A C D F ∂U ∂β A C d dβ d dβ 1 kT2 d dβ dβ dT d dT 1 β hc# (1 + βhc# + · · · ) − 1 0 5 10 10 5 0 T/ V áñ V /hc~ q en Fig. 17.9 The mean vibrational energy of a molecule in the harmonic approximation as a function of temperature. At high temperatures (T >> θV), the energy is linearly proportional to the temperature, in accord with the equipartition theorem. Exploration Plot the temperature dependence of the mean vibrational energy for several values of the vibrational wavenumber (for reasonable values of the vibrational wavenumber, see the Data section). From your plots, estimate the temperature at which the mean vibrational energy begins to increase sharply. 602 17 STATISTICAL THERMODYNAMICS 2: APPLICATIONS calculate the rotational heat capacity at intermediate temperatures by differentiating the equation for the mean rotational energy (eqn 17.26). The resulting (untidy) expression, which is plotted in Fig. 17.10, shows that the contribution rises from zero (when T = 0) to the equipartition value (when T >> θR). Because the translational contribution is always present, we can expect the molar heat capacity of a gas of diatomic molecules (CT V,m + CR V,m) to rise from 3 –2R to 5 –2R as the temperature is increased above θR. Problem 17.19 explores how the overall shape of the curve can be traced to the sum of thermal excitations between all the available rotational energy levels (Fig. 17.11). Molecular vibrations contribute to the heat capacity, but only when the temperature is high enough for them to be significantly excited. The equipartition mean energy is kT for each mode, so the maximum contribution to the molar heat capacity is R. However, it is very unusual for the vibrations to be so highly excited that equipartition is valid, and it is more appropriate to use the full expression for the vibrational heat capacity, which is obtained by differentiating eqn 17.28: CV V,m = Rf f = 2 2 (17.34) where θV = hc#/k is the characteristic vibrational temperature. The curve in Fig. 17.12 shows how the vibrational heat capacity depends on temperature. Note that even when the temperature is only slightly above θV the heat capacity is close to its equipartition value. D F e−θV/2T 1 − e−θV/T A C D F θV T A C 1 0 CRV,m/ T/ R 0 2 q Fig. 17.10 The temperature dependence of the rotational contribution to the heat capacity of a linear molecule. Exploration The Living graphs section of the text’s web site has applets for the calculation of the temperature dependence of the rotational contribution to the heat capacity. Explore the effect of the rotational constant on the plot of CR V,m against T. Comment 17.2 Equation 17.34 is essentially the same as the Einstein formula for the heat capacity of a solid (eqn 8.7) with θV the Einstein temperature, θE. The only difference is that vibrations can take place in three dimensions in a solid. 0,1 0,2 1,2 0,31,3 0 1 2 3 4 5 0 1 Total Temperature, /T R CRm/ q Fig. 17.11 The rotational heat capacity of a linear molecule can be regarded as the sum of contributions from a collection of two-level systems, in which the rise in temperature stimulates transitions between J levels, some of which are shown here. The calculation on which this illustration is based is sketched in Problem 17.19. 17.4 HEAT CAPACITIES 603 1 0 CRV,m/ 0 1 T/ Vq T T R+ T R V+ + 2 Atoms (T)´ Dissociation 3 2 CRV,m/ R V Temperature 3 - 2 5 - 2 7 q q Fig. 17.12 The temperature dependence of the vibrational heat capacity of a molecule in the harmonic approximation calculated by using eqn 17.34. Note that the heat capacity is within 10 per cent of its classical value for temperatures greater than θV. Exploration The Living graphs section of the text’s web site has applets for the calculation of the temperature dependence of the vibrational contribution to the heat capacity. Explore the effect of the vibrational wavenumber on the plot of CV V,m against T. Fig. 17.13 The general features of the temperature dependence of the heat capacity of diatomic molecules are as shown here. Each mode becomes active when its characteristic temperature is exceeded. The heat capacity becomes very large when the molecule dissociates because the energy is used to cause dissociation and not to raise the temperature. Then it falls back to the translation-only value of the atoms. (b) The overall heat capacity The total heat capacity of a molecular substance is the sum of each contribution (Fig. 17.13). When equipartition is valid (when the temperature is well above the characteristic temperature of the mode, T >> θM) we can estimate the heat capacity by counting the numbers of modes that are active. In gases, all three translational modes are always active and contribute 3 –2R to the molar heat capacity. If we denote the number of active rotational modes by ν*R (so for most molecules at normal temperatures ν*R = 2 for linear molecules, and 3 for nonlinear molecules), then the rotational contribution is 1 –2ν*RR. If the temperature is high enough for ν*V vibrational modes to be active, the vibrational contribution to the molar heat capacity is ν*VR. In most cases ν*V ≈ 0. It follows that the total molar heat capacity is CV,m = 1 –2(3 + ν*R + 2ν*V)R (17.35) Example 17.5 Estimating the molar heat capacity of a gas Estimate the molar constant-volume heat capacity of water vapour at 100°C. Vibrational wavenumbers are given in Example 17.3; the rotational constants of an H2O molecule are 27.9, 14.5, and 9.3 cm−1 . 604 17 STATISTICAL THERMODYNAMICS 2: APPLICATIONS Method We need to assess whether the rotational and vibrational modes are active by computing their characteristic temperatures from the data (to do so, use hc/k = 1.439 cm K). Answer The characteristic temperatures (in round numbers) of the vibrations are 5300 K, 2300 K, and 5400 K; the vibrations are therefore not excited at 373 K. The three rotational modes have characteristic temperatures 40 K, 21 K, and 13 K, so they are fully excited, like the three translational modes. The translational contribution is 3 –2R = 12.5 J K−1 mol−1 . Fully excited rotations contribute a further 12.5 J K−1 mol−1 . Therefore, a value close to 25 J K−1 mol−1 is predicted. The experimental value is 26.1 J K−1 mol−1 . The discrepancy is probably due to deviations from perfect gas behaviour. Self-test 17.5 Estimate the molar constant-volume heat capacity of gaseous I2 at 25°C (B = 0.037 cm−1 ; see Table 13.2 for more data). [29 J K−1 mol−1 ] 17.5 Equations of state The relation between p and Q in eqn 17.3 is a very important route to the equations of state of real gases in terms of intermolecular forces, for the latter can be built into Q. We have already seen (Example 17.1) that the partition function for a gas of independent particles leads to the perfect gas equation of state, pV = nRT. Real gases differ from perfect gases in their equations of state and we saw in Section 1.3 that their equations of state may be written = 1 + + + · · · (17.36) where B is the second virial coefficient and C is the third virial coefficient. The total kinetic energy of a gas is the sum of the kinetic energies of the individual molecules. Therefore, even in a real gas the canonical partition function factorizes into a part arising from the kinetic energy, which is the same as for the perfect gas, and a factor called the configuration integral, Z, which depends on the intermolecular potentials. We therefore write Q = (17.37) By comparing this equation with eqn 16.45 (Q = qN /N!, with q = V/Λ3 ), we see that for a perfect gas of atoms (with no contributions from rotational or vibrational modes) Z = (17.38) For a real gas of atoms (for which the intermolecular interactions are isotropic), Z is related to the total potential energy EP of interaction of all the particles by Z = Ύe−βEP dτ1dτ2 · · · dτN (17.39) where dτi is the volume element for atom i. The physical origin of this term is that the probability of occurrence of each arrangement of molecules possible in the sample is given by a Boltzmann distribution in which the exponent is given by the potential energy corresponding to that arrangement. 1 N! VN N! Z Λ3N C V2 m B Vm pVm RT 17.5 EQUATIONS OF STATE 605 Illustration 17.1 Calculating a configuration integral When the molecules do not interact with one another, EP = 0 and hence e−βEP = 1. Then Z = Ύdτ1dτ2 · · · dτN = because ∫dτ = V, where V is the volume of the container. This result coincides with eqn 17.39. When we consider only interactions between pairs of particles the configuration integral simplifies to Z = 1 –2Ύe−βEP dτ1dτ2 (17.40) The second virial coefficient then turns out to be B = − Ύf dτ1dτ2 (17.41) The quantity f is the Mayer f-function: it goes to zero when the two particles are so far apart that EP = 0. When the intermolecular interaction depends only on the separation r of the particles and not on their relative orientation or their absolute position in space, as in the interaction of closed-shell atoms in a uniform sample, the volume element simplifies to 4πr2 dr (because the integrals over the angular variables in dτ = r2 dr sin θ dθdφ give a factor of 4π) and eqn 17.41 becomes B = −2πNAΎ ∞ 0 fr2 dr f = e−βEP − 1 (17.42) The integral can be evaluated (usually numerically) by substituting an expression for the intermolecular potential energy. Intermolecular potential energies are discussed in more detail in Chapter 18, where several expressions are developed for them. At this stage, we can illustrate how eqn 17.42 is used by considering the hard-sphere potential, which is infinite when the separation of the two molecules, r, is less than or equal to a certain value σ, and is zero for greater separations. Then e−βEP = 0 f = −1 when r ≤ σ (and EP = ∞) (17.43a) e−βEP = 1 f = 0 when r > σ (and EP = 0) (17.43b) It follows from eqn 17.42 that the second virial coefficient is B = 2πNAΎ σ 0 r2 dr= 2 –3πNAσ3 (17.44) This calculation of B raises the question as to whether a potential can be found that, when the virial coefficients are evaluated, gives the van der Waals equation of state. Such a potential can be found for weak attractive interactions (a << RT): it consists of a hard-sphere repulsive core and a long-range, shallow attractive region (see Problem 17.15). A further point is that, once a second virial coefficient has been calculated for a given intermolecular potential, it is possible to calculate other thermodynamic properties that depend on the form of the potential. For example, it is possible to NA 2V VN N! 1 N! 606 17 STATISTICAL THERMODYNAMICS 2: APPLICATIONS calculate the isothermal Joule–Thomson coefficient, µT (Section 3.8), from the thermodynamic relation p→0 lim µT = B − T (17.45) and from the result calculate the Joule–Thomson coefficient itself by using eqn 3.48. 17.6 Molecular interactions in liquids The starting point for the discussion of solids is the well ordered structure of a perfect crystal, which will be discussed in Chapter 20. The starting point for the discussion of gases is the completely disordered distribution of the molecules of a perfect gas, as we saw in Chapter 1. Liquids lie between these two extremes. We shall see that the structural and thermodynamic properties of liquids depend on the nature of intermolecular interactions and that an equation of state can be built in a similar way to that just demonstrated for real gases. (a) The radial distribution function The average relative locations of the particles of a liquid are expressed in terms of the radial distribution function, g(r). This function is defined so that g(r)r2 dr is the probability that a molecule will be found in the range dr at a distance r from another molecule. In a perfect crystal, g(r) is a periodic array of sharp spikes, representing the certainty (in the absence of defects and thermal motion) that molecules (or ions) lie at definite locations. This regularity continues out to the edges of the crystal, so we say that crystals have long-range order. When the crystal melts, the long-range order is lost and, wherever we look at long distances from a given molecule, there is equal probability of finding a second molecule. Close to the first molecule, though, the nearest neighbours might still adopt approximately their original relative positions and, even if they are displaced by newcomers, the new particles might adopt their vacated positions. It is still possible to detect a sphere of nearest neighbours at a distance r1, and perhaps beyond them a sphere of next-nearest neighbours at r2. The existence of this short-range order means that the radial distribution function can be expected to oscillate at short distances, with a peak at r1, a smaller peak at r2, and perhaps some more structure beyond that. The radial distribution function of the oxygen atoms in liquid water is shown in Fig. 17.14. Closer analysis shows that any given H2O molecule is surrounded by other molecules at the corners of a tetrahedron. The form of g(r) at 100°C shows that the intermolecular interactions (in this case, principally by hydrogen bonds) are strong enough to affect the local structure right up to the boiling point. Raman spectra indicate that in liquid water most molecules participate in either three or four hydrogen bonds. Infrared spectra show that about 90 per cent of hydrogen bonds are intact at the melting point of ice, falling to about 20 per cent at the boiling point. The formal expression for the radial distribution function for molecules 1 and 2 in a fluid consisting of N particles is the somewhat fearsome equation g(r12) = (17.46) where β = 1/kT and VN is the N-particle potential energy. Although fearsome, this expression is nothing more than the Boltzmann distribution for the relative locations of two molecules in a field provided by all the other molecules in the system. ΎΎ· · · Ύe−βVN dτ3dτ4 . . . dτN N2 ΎΎ· · · Ύe−βVN dτ1dτ2 . . . dτN dB dT g r( ) 2 1 100°C 25°C 4°C 10000 200 600 r/pm Fig. 17.14 The radial distribution function of the oxygen atoms in liquid water at three temperatures. Note the expansion as the temperature is raised. (A.H. Narten, M.D. Danford, and H.A. Levy, Discuss. Faraday. Soc. 43, 97 (1967).) 17.6 MOLECULAR INTERACTIONS IN LIQUIDS 607 (b) The calculation of g(r) Because the radial distribution function can be calculated by making assumptions about the intermolecular interactions, it can be used to test theories of liquid structure. However, even a fluid of hard spheres without attractive interactions (a collection of ball-bearings in a container) gives a function that oscillates near the origin (Fig. 17.15), and one of the factors influencing, and sometimes dominating, the structure of a liquid is the geometrical problem of stacking together reasonably hard spheres. Indeed, the radial distribution function of a liquid of hard spheres shows more pronounced oscillations at a given temperature than that of any other type of liquid. The attractive part of the potential modifies this basic structure, but sometimes only quite weakly. One of the reasons behind the difficulty of describing liquids theoretically is the similar importance of both the attractive and repulsive (hard core) components of the potential. There are several ways of building the intermolecular potential into the calculation of g(r). Numerical methods take a box of about 103 particles (the number increases as computers grow more powerful), and the rest of the liquid is simulated by surrounding the box with replications of the original box (Fig. 17.16). Then, whenever a particle leaves the box through one of its faces, its image arrives through the opposite face. When calculating the interactions of a molecule in a box, it interacts with all the molecules in the box and all the periodic replications of those molecules and itself in the other boxes. In the Monte Carlo method, the particles in the box are moved through small but otherwise random distances, and the change in total potential energy of the N particles in the box, ∆VN, is calculated using one of the intermolecular potentials discussed in Section 18.4. Whether or not this new configuration is accepted is then judged from the following rules: 1 If the potential energy is not greater than before the change, then the configuration is accepted. If the potential energy is greater than before the change, then it is necessary to check if the new configuration is reasonable and can exist in equilibrium with configurations of lower potential energy at a given temperature. To make progress, we use the result that, at equilibrium, the ratio of populations of two states with energy separation ∆VN is e−∆VN/kT . Because we are testing the viability of a configuration with a higher potential energy than the previous configuration in the calculation, ∆VN > 0 and the exponential factor varies between 0 and 1. In the Monte Carlo method, the second rule, therefore, is: 2 The exponential factor is compared with a random number between 0 and 1; if the factor is larger than the random number, then the configuration is accepted; if the factor is not larger, the configuration is rejected. The configurations generated with Monte Carlo calculations can be used to construct g(r) simply by counting the number of pairs of particles with a separation r and averaging the result over the whole collection of configurations. In the molecular dynamics approach, the history of an initial arrangement is followed by calculating the trajectories of all the particles under the influence of the intermolecular potentials. To appreciate what is involved, we consider the motion of a particle in one dimension. We show in the following Justification that, after a time interval ∆t, the position of a particle changes from xi−1 to a new value xi given by xi = xi−1 + vi−1∆t (17.47) where vi−1 is the velocity of the atom when it was at xi−1, its location at the start of the interval. The velocity at xi is related to vi−1, the velocity at the start of the interval, by High density Low density 1 2 3 40 1 Radialdistributionfunction,g R d/ Fig. 17.15 The radial distribution function for a simulation of a liquid using impenetrable hard spheres (ball bearings). Fig. 17.16 In a two-dimensional simulation of a liquid that uses periodic boundary conditions, when one particle leaves the cell its mirror image enters through the opposite face. 608 17 STATISTICAL THERMODYNAMICS 2: APPLICATIONS vi = vi−1 − m−1 xi−1 ∆t (17.48) where the derivative of the potential energy VN(x) is evaluated at xi−1. The time interval ∆t is approximately 1 fs (10−15 s), which is shorter than the average time between collisions. The calculation of xi and vi is then repeated for tens of thousands of such steps. The time-consuming part of the calculation is the evaluation of the net force on the molecule arising from all the other molecules present in the system. Justification 17.3 Particle trajectories according to molecular dynamics Consider a particle of mass m moving along the x direction with an initial velocity v1 given by v1 = If the initial and new positions of the atom are x1 and x2, then ∆x = x2 − x1 and x2 = x1 + v1∆t The particle moves under the influence of a force arising from interactions with other atoms in the molecule. From Newton’s second law of motion, we write the force F1 at x1 as F1 = ma1 where the acceleration a1 at x1 is given by a1 = ∆v/∆t. If the initial and new velocities are v1 and v2, then ∆v = v2 − v1 and v2 = v1 + a1∆t = v1 + ∆t Because F = −dV/dx, the force acting on the atom is related to the potential energy of interaction with other nearby atoms, the potential energy VN(x), by F1 = − x1 where the derivative is evaluated at x1. It follows that v2 = v1 − m−1 x1 ∆t This expression generalizes to eqn 17.48 for the calculation of a velocity vi from a previous velocity vi−1. Self-test 17.6 Consider a particle of mass m connected to a stationary wall with a spring of force constant k. Write an expression for the velocity of this particle once it is set into motion in the x direction from an equilibrium position x0. [vi = vi−1 + (k/m)(xi−1 − x0)] A molecular dynamics calculation gives a series of snapshots of the liquid, and g(r) can be calculated as before. The temperature of the system is inferred by computing the mean kinetic energy of the particles and using the equipartition result that ͗1 –2mvq 2 ͘ = 1 –2kT (17.49) for each coordinate q. dVN(x) dx dVN(x) dx F1 m ∆x ∆t dVN(x) dx 17.7 RESIDUAL ENTROPIES 609 (c) The thermodynamic properties of liquids Once g(r) is known it can be used to calculate the thermodynamic properties of liquids. For example, the contribution of the pairwise additive intermolecular potential, V2, to the internal energy is given by the integral U = Ύ ∞ 0 g(r)V2r2 dr (17.50) That is, U is essentially the average two-particle potential energy weighted by g(r)r2 dr, which is the probability that the pair of particles have a separation between r and r + dr. Likewise, the contribution that pairwise interactions make to the pressure is = 1 − Ύ ∞ 0 g(r)v2r2 dr v2 = r (17.51a) The quantity v2 is called the virial (hence the term ‘virial equation of state’). To understand the physical content of this expression, we rewrite it as p = − 2π 2 Ύ ∞ 0 g(r)v2r2 dr (17.51b) The first term on the right is the kinetic pressure, the contribution to the pressure from the impact of the molecules in free flight. The second term is essentially the internal pressure, πT = (∂U/∂V)T, introduced in Section 2.11, representing the contribution to the pressure from the intermolecular forces. To see the connection, we should recognize −dV2/dr (in v2) as the force required to move two molecules apart, and therefore −r(dV2/dr) as the work required to separate the molecules through a distance r. The second term is therefore the average of this work over the range of pairwise separations in the liquid as represented by the probability of finding two molecules at separations between r and r + dr, which is g(r)r2 dr. In brief, the integral, when multiplied by the square of the number density, is the change in internal energy of the system as it expands, and therefore is equal to the internal pressure. 17.7 Residual entropies Entropies may be calculated from spectroscopic data; they may also be measured experimentally (Section 3.3). In many cases there is good agreement, but in some the experimental entropy is less than the calculated value. One possibility is that the experimental determination failed to take a phase transition into account (and a contribution of the form ∆trsH/Ttrs incorrectly omitted from the sum). Another possibility is that some disorder is present in the solid even at T = 0. The entropy at T = 0 is then greater than zero and is called the residual entropy. The origin and magnitude of the residual entropy can be explained by considering a crystal composed of AB molecules, where A and B are similar atoms (such as CO, with its very small electric dipole moment). There may be so little energy difference between . . .AB AB AB AB. . . , . . .AB BA BA AB. . . , and other arrangements that the molecules adopt the orientations AB and BA at random in the solid. We can readily calculate the entropy arising from residual disorder by using the Boltzmann formula S = k ln W. To do so, we suppose that two orientations are equally probable, and that the sample consists of N molecules. Because the same energy can be achieved in 2N different ways (because each molecule can take either of two orientations), the total number of ways of achieving the same energy is W = 2N . It follows that S = k ln 2N = Nk ln 2 = nR ln 2 (17.52a) D F N V A C nRT V dV2 dr 2πN kTV pV nRT 2πN2 V 610 17 STATISTICAL THERMODYNAMICS 2: APPLICATIONS Fig. 17.17 The possible locations of H atoms around a central O atom in an ice crystal are shown by the white spheres. Only one of the locations on each bond may be occupied by an atom, and two H atoms must be close to the O atom and two H atoms must be distant from it. Fig. 17.18 The six possible arrangements of H atoms in the locations identified in Fig. 17.17. Occupied locations are denoted by red spheres and unoccupied locations by white spheres. We can therefore expect a residual molar entropy of R ln 2 = 5.8 J K−1 mol−1 for solids composed of molecules that can adopt either of two orientations at T = 0. If s orientations are possible, the residual molar entropy will be Sm = R ln s (17.52b) An FClO3 molecule, for example, can adopt four orientations with about the same energy (with the F atom at any of the four corners of a tetrahedron), and the calculated residual molar entropy of R ln 4 = 11.5 J K−1 mol−1 is in good agreement with the experimental value (10.1 J K−1 mol−1 ). For CO, the measured residual entropy is 5 J K−1 mol−1 , which is close to R ln 2, the value expected for a random structure of the form . . .CO CO OC CO OC OC. . . . Illustration 17.2 Calculating a residual entropy Consider a sample of ice with N H2O molecules. Each O atom is surrounded tetrahedrally by four H atoms, two of which are attached by short σ bonds, the other two being attached by long hydrogen bonds (Fig. 17.17). It follows that each of the 2N H atoms can be in one of two positions (either close to or far from an O atom as shown in Fig. 17.18), resulting in 22N possible arrangements. However, not all these arrangements are acceptable. Indeed, of the 24 = 16 ways of arranging four H atoms around one O atom, only 6 have two short and two long OH distances and hence are acceptable. Therefore, the number of permitted arrangements is W = 22N (6 –16)N = (3 –2)N It then follows that the residual molar entropy is Sm(0) ≈ k ln(3 –2)NA = NAk ln(3 –2) = R ln(3 –2) = 3.4 J K−1 mol−1 which is in good agreement with the experimental value of 3.4 J K−1 mol−1 . The model, however, is not exact because it ignores the possibility that next-nearest neighbours and those beyond can influence the local arrangement of bonds. 17.8 Equilibrium constants The Gibbs energy of a gas of independent molecules is given by eqn 17.9 in terms of the molar partition function, qm = q/n. The equilibrium constant K of a reaction is related to the standard Gibbs energy of reaction by ∆rG7 = −RT ln K. To calculate the equilibrium constant, we need to combine these two equations. We shall consider gas phase reactions in which the equilibrium constant is expressed in terms of the partial pressures of the reactants and products. 17.8 EQUILIBRIUM CONSTANTS 611 (a) The relation between K and the partition function To find an expression for the standard reaction Gibbs energy we need expressions for the standard molar Gibbs energies, G7 /n, of each species. For these expressions, we need the value of the molar partition function when p = p7 (where p7 = 1 bar): we denote this standard molar partition function q7 m. Because only the translational component depends on the pressure, we can find q7 m by evaluating the partition function with V replaced by V7 m, where V7 m = RT/p7 . For a species J it follows that G7 m(J) = G7 m(J,0) − RT ln (17.53)° where q7 J,m is the standard molar partition function of J. By combining expressions like this one (as shown in the Justification below), the equilibrium constant for the reaction a A + b B → c C + d D is given by the expression K = e−∆rE0/RT (17.54a) where ∆rE0 is the difference in molar energies of the ground states of the products and reactants (this term is defined more precisely in the Justification), and is calculated from the bond dissociation energies of the species (Fig. 17.19). In terms of the stoichiometric numbers introduced in Section 7.2, we would write K = Π J νJ e−∆rE0/RT (17.54b) Justification 17.4 The equilibrium constant in terms of the partition function 1 The standard molar reaction Gibbs energy for the reaction is ∆rG7 = cG7 m(C) + dG7 m(D) − aG7 m(A) − bG7 m(B) = cG7 m(C,0) + dG7 m(D,0) − aG7 m(A,0) − bG7 m(B,0) − RT c ln + d ln − a ln − b ln Because G(0) = U(0), the first term on the right is ∆rE0 = cU7 m(C,0) + dU 7 m(D,0) − aU7 m(A,0) − bU7 m(B,0) (17.55) the reaction internal energy at T = 0 (a molar quantity). Now we can write ∆rG7 = ∆rE0 − RT ln c + ln d − ln a − ln b = ∆rE0 − RT ln = −RT + ln At this stage we can pick out an expression for K by comparing this equation with ∆rG7 = −RT ln K, which gives 5 6 7 (q7 C,m/NA)c (q7 D,m/NA)d (q7 A,m/NA)a (q7 B,m/NA)b ∆rE0 RT 1 2 3 (q7 C,m/NA)c (q7 D,m/NA)d (q7 A,m/NA)a (q7 B,m/NA)b 5 6 7 D E F q7 B,m NA A B C D E F q7 A,m NA A B C D E F q7 D,m NA A B C D E F q7 C,m NA A B C 1 2 3 5 6 7 q7 B,m NA q7 A,m NA q7 D,m NA q7 C,m NA 1 2 3 5 6 7 D F q7 J,m NA A C 1 2 3 (q7 C,m/NA)c (q7 D,m/NA)d (q7 A,m/NA)a (q7 B,m/NA)b q7 J,m NA D0(reactants) D0(products) Dr 0E Fig. 17.19 The definition of ∆rE0 for the calculation of equilibrium constants. 612 17 STATISTICAL THERMODYNAMICS 2: APPLICATIONS ln K = − + ln This expression is easily rearranged into eqn 17.54a by forming the exponential of both sides. (b) A dissociation equilibrium We shall illustrate the application of eqn 17.54 to an equilibrium in which a diatomic molecule X2 dissociates into its atoms: X2(g) 5 2 X(g) K = According to eqn 17.54 (with a = 1, b = 0, c = 2, and d = 0): K = e−∆rE0/RT = e−∆rE0/RT (17.56a) with ∆rE0 = 2U7 m(X,0) − U7 m(X2,0) = D0(X-X) (17.56b) where D0(X-X) is the dissociation energy of the X-X bond. The standard molar partition functions of the atoms X are q7 X,m = gX = where gX is the degeneracy of the electronic ground state of X and we have used V7 m = RT/p7 . The diatomic molecule X2 also has rotational and vibrational degrees of freedom, so its standard molar partition function is q7 X2,m = gX2 qR X2 qV X2 = where gX2 is the degeneracy of the electronic ground state of X2. It follows from eqn 17.54 that the equilibrium constant is K = e−D0/RT (17.57) where we have used R/NA = k. All the quantities in this expression can be calculated from spectroscopic data. The Λs are defined in Table 17.3 and depend on the masses of the species and the temperature; the expressions for the rotational and vibrational partition functions are also available in Table 17.3 and depend on the rotational constant and vibrational wavenumber of the molecule. Example 17.6 Evaluating an equilibrium constant Evaluate the equilibrium constant for the dissociation Na2(g) 5 2 Na(g) at 1000 K from the following data: B = 0.1547 cm−1 , # = 159.2 cm−1 , D0 = 70.4 kJ mol−1 . The Na atoms have doublet ground terms. Method The partition functions required are specified in eqn 17.54. They are evaluated by using the expressions in Table 17.3. For a homonuclear diatomic molecule, σ = 2. In the evaluation of kT/p7 use p7 = 105 Pa and 1 Pa m3 = 1 J. kTg2 XΛ3 X2 p7 gX2 qR X2 qV X2 Λ6 X RTgX2 qR X2 qV X2 p7 Λ3 X2 D F V 7 m Λ3 X2 A C RTgX p7 Λ3 X D F V7 m Λ3 X A C (q7 X,m)2 q7 X2,mNA (q7 X,m/NA)2 q7 X2,m/NA p2 X pX2 p7 (q7 C,m/NA)c (q7 D,m/NA)d (q7 A,m/NA)a (q7 B,m/NA)b ∆rE0 RT 17.8 EQUILIBRIUM CONSTANTS 613 DE0 R P Fig. 17.20 The array of R(eactants) and P(roducts) energy levels. At equilibrium all are accessible (to differing extents, depending on the temperature), and the equilibrium composition of the system reflects the overall Bolzmann distribution of populations. As ∆E0 increases, R becomes dominant. Comment 17.3 For an R 5 P equilibrium, the V factors in the partition functions cancel, so the appearance of q in place of q7 has no effect. In the case of a more general reaction, the conversion from q to q7 comes about at the stage of converting the pressures that occur in K to numbers of molecules. Answer The partition functions and other quantities required are as follows: Λ(Na2) = 8.14 pm Λ(Na) = 11.5 pm qR (Na2) = 2246 qV (Na2) = 4.885 g(Na) = 2 g(Na2) = 1 Then, from eqn 17.54, K = × e−8.47 = 2.42 where we have used 1 J = 1 kg m2 s−2 and 1 Pa = 1 kg m−1 s−1 . Self-test 17.7 Evaluate K at 1500 K. [52] (c) Contributions to the equilibrium constant We are now in a position to appreciate the physical basis of equilibrium constants. To see what is involved, consider a simple R 5 P gas-phase equilibrium (R for reactants, P for products). Figure 17.20 shows two sets of energy levels; one set of states belongs to R, and the other belongs to P. The populations of the states are given by the Boltzmann distribution, and are independent of whether any given state happens to belong to R or to P. We can therefore imagine a single Boltzmann distribution spreading, without distinction, over the two sets of states. If the spacings of R and P are similar (as in Fig. 17.20), and P lies above R, the diagram indicates that R will dominate in the equilibrium mixture. However, if P has a high density of states (a large number of states in a given energy range, as in Fig. 17.21), then, even though its zero-point energy lies above that of R, the species P might still dominate at equilibrium. It is quite easy to show (see the Justification below) that the ratio of numbers of R and P molecules at equilibrium is given by = e−∆rE0/RT (17.58a) and therefore that the equilibrium constant for the reaction is K = e−∆rE0/RT (17.58b) just as would be obtained from eqn 17.54. Justification 17.5 The equilibrium constant in terms of the partition function 2 The population in a state i of the composite (R,P) system is ni = where N is the total number of molecules. The total number of R molecules is the sum of these populations taken over the states belonging to R; these states we label r with energies εr. The total number of P molecules is the sum over the states Ne−βεi q qP qR qP qR NP NR (1.38 × 10−23 J K−1 ) × (1000 K) × 4 × (8.14 × 10−12 m)3 (105 Pa) × 2246 × 4.885 × (1.15 × 10−11 m)6 614 17 STATISTICAL THERMODYNAMICS 2: APPLICATIONS belonging to P; these states we label p with energies εp′ (the prime is explained in a moment): NR = ∑ r nr = ∑ r e−βεr NP = ∑ p np = ∑ p e−βε′p The sum over the states of R is its partition function, qR, so NR = The sum over the states of P is also a partition function, but the energies are measured from the ground state of the combined system, which is the ground state of R. However, because ε′p = εp + ∆ε0, where ∆ε0 is the separation of zero-point energies (as in Fig. 17.21), NP = ∑ p e−β(εp+∆ε0) = ∑ p e−βεp e−β∆ε0 = e−∆rE0/RT The switch from ∆ε0/k to ∆rE0/R in the last step is the conversion of molecular energies to molar energies. The equilibrium constant of the R 5 P reaction is proportional to the ratio of the numbers of the two types of molecule. Therefore, K = = e−∆rE0/RT as in eqn 17.58b. The content of eqn 17.58 can be seen most clearly by exaggerating the molecular features that contribute to it. We shall suppose that R has only a single accessible level, which implies that qR = 1. We also suppose that P has a large number of evenly, closely spaced levels (Fig. 17.22). The partition function of P is then qP = kT/ε. In this model system, the equilibrium constant is K = e−∆rE0/RT (17.59) When ∆rE0 is very large, the exponential term dominates and K << 1, which implies that very little P is present at equilibrium. When ∆rE0 is small but still positive, K can exceed 1 because the factor kT/ε may be large enough to overcome the small size of the exponential term. The size of K then reflects the predominance of P at equilibrium on account of its high density of states. At low temperatures K << 1 and the system consists entirely of R. At high temperatures the exponential function approaches 1 and the pre-exponential factor is large. Hence P becomes dominant. We see that, in this endothermic reaction (endothermic because P lies above R), a rise in temperature favours P, because its states become accessible. This behaviour is what we saw, from the outside, in Chapter 7. The model also shows why the Gibbs energy, G, and not just the enthalpy, determines the position of equilibrium. It shows that the density of states (and hence the entropy) of each species as well as their relative energies controls the distribution of populations and hence the value of the equilibrium constant. kT ε qP qR NP NR NqP q D E F A B C N q N q NqR q N q N q DE0 R P Fig. 17.21 It is important to take into account the densities of states of the molecules. Even though P might lie well above R in energy (that is, ∆E0 is large and positive), P might have so many states that its total population dominates in the mixture. In classical thermodynamic terms, we have to take entropies into account as well as enthalpies when considering equilibria. DE0 R P e Fig. 17.22 The model used in the text for exploring the effects of energy separations and densities of states on equilibria. The products P can dominate provided ∆E0 is not too large and P has an appreciable density of states. FURTHER READING 615 Checklist of key ideas 1. The molecular partition function can be written as q = qT qR qV qE , with the contributions summarized in Table 17.3. 2. Thermodynamic functions can be expressed in terms of the partition function as summarized in Table 17.4. 3. The mean energy of a mode is ͗εM ͘ = −(1/qM )(∂qM /∂β)V, with the contributions from each mode summarized in Table 17.5. 4. The contribution of a mode M to the constant-volume heat capacity is CM V = −Nkβ(∂͗εM ͘/∂β)V, with the contributions from each mode summarized in Table 17.5. 5. The overall heat capacity is written as CV,m = 1 –2(3 + νR* + 2νV*)R 6. The canonical partition function of a gas is Q = Z/Λ3N ,where Z is the configuration integral: Z = VN /N! for a perfect gas, and Z = (1/N!)∫e−βEP dτ1dτ2 . . . dτN for a real gas. 7. In the virial equation of state, the second virial coefficient can be written as B = −(NA/2V)∫fdτ1dτ2, where the Mayer f-function is f = e−βEP − 1. 8. The radial distribution function, g(r), where g(r)r2 dr, is the probability that a molecule will be found in the range dr at a distance r from another molecule. The internal energy and pressure of a fluid may be expressed in terms of the radial distribution function (eqns 17.50 and 17.51, respectively). 9. The residual entropy is a non-zero entropy at T = 0 arising from molecular disorder. 10. The equilibrium constant can be written in terms of the partition function (eqn 17.54). Further reading Articles and texts D. Chandler, Introduction to modern statistical mechanics. Oxford University Press (1987). K.A. Dill and S. Bromberg, Molecular driving forces: statistical thermodynamics in chemistry and biology. Garland Publishing (2002). T.L. Hill, An introduction to statistical thermodynamics. Dover, New York (1986). D.A. McQuarrie and J.D. Simon, Molecular thermodynamics. University Science Books, Sausalito (1999). B. Widom, Statistical mechanics: a concise introduction for chemists. Cambridge University Press (2002). Table 17.3 Contributions to the molecular partition function Mode Expression Value Translation qT = Λ = Λ/pm = = = 2.561 × 10−2 (T/K)5/2 (M/g mol−1 )3/2 Rotation Linear molecules qR = = θR = qR = × Nonlinear molecules qR = 3/2 1/2 qR = × Vibration qV = = θV = = For T >> θV, qV = = qV = 0.695 × Electronic qE = g0 [+ higher terms] where g0 is the degeneracy of the electronic ground state Note that β = 1/kT. T/K #/cm−1 T θV kT hc# hν k hc# k 1 1 − e−θV/T 1 1 − e−hc#/kT (T/K)3/2 (ABC/cm−3 )1/2 1.0270 σ D E F π ABC A B C D E F kT hc A B C 1 σ T/K (B/cm−1 ) 0.6950 σ hcB k T θR kT σhcB qT7 m NA kT p7 Λ3 qT7 m NA 1749 (T/K)1/2 (M/g mol−1 )1/2 h (2πmkT)1/2 V Λ3 616 17 STATISTICAL THERMODYNAMICS 2: APPLICATIONS Table 17.5 Contributions to mean energies and heat capacities Mode Expression Mean energy Heat capacity* General mode, M ͗εM ͘ = − V = − V CV M = −Nkβ2 V Translation ͗εT ͘ = 3 –2kT CT V = 3 –2nR Rotation (T >> θR) ͗εR ͘ = kT, linear molecules CR = nR, linear molecules ͗εR ͘ = 3 –2kT, nonlinear molecules CR = 3 –2nR, nonlinear molecules Vibration ͗εV ͘ = = CV = nRf, f = 2 Vibration (T >> θV) ͗εV ͘ = kT CV = nR * No distinction need be made between CV and Cp for internal modes. e−θV/T (1 − e−θV/T )2 D E F θV T A B C hν e−θV/T − 1 hcν e−θV/T − 1 D E F ∂͗εM ͘ ∂β A B C D E F ∂qM ∂β A B C 1 qM D E F ∂ ln qM ∂β A B C Table 17.4 Thermodynamic functions in terms of the partition function Function Expression General case Independent molecules* Internal energy U(T) − U(0) = − V U(T) − U(0) = −N V Entropy S = + k ln Q S = + Nk ln q (a) S = + Nk ln (b) Helmholtz energy A(T) − A(0) = −kT ln Q A(T) − A(0) = −NkT ln q (a) A(T) − A(0) = −NkT ln (b) Pressure p = kT T p = NkT T (b) Enthalpy H(T) − H(0) = − V + kTV T H(T) − H(0) = −N V + NkTV T Gibbs energy G(T ) − G(0) = −kT ln Q + kTV T G(T) − G(0) = −NkT ln q + NkTV T (a) G(T) − G(0) = −NkT ln + NkTV T (b) * (a) is for distinguishable particles (from Q = qN ), (b) for indistinquishable particles (from Q = qN /N!). D E F ∂ ln q ∂V A B C eq N D E F ∂lnq ∂V A B C D E F ∂ ln Q ∂V A B C D E F ∂ ln q ∂V A B C D E F ∂ ln q ∂β A B C D E F ∂ ln Q ∂V A B C D E F ∂ ln Q ∂β A B C D E F ∂ ln q ∂V A B C D E F ∂ ln Q ∂V A B C eq N eq N U(T) − U(0) T U(T) − U(0) T U(T) − U(0) T D E F ∂ ln q ∂β A B C D E F ∂ ln Q ∂β A B C EXERCISES 617 Discussion questions 17.1 Discuss the limitations of the expressions qR = kT/hcB, qV = kT/hc#, and qE = gE . 17.2 Explain the origin of the symmetry number. 17.3 Explain the origin of residual entropy. 17.4 Use concepts of statistical thermodynamics to describe the molecular features that determine the magnitudes of the constant-volume molar heat capacity of a molecular substance. 17.5 Use concepts of statistical thermodynamics to describe the molecular features that lead to the equations of state of perfect and real gases. 17.6 Describe how liquids are investigated by using concepts of statistical thermodynamics. 17.7 Use concepts of statistical thermodynamics to describe the molecular features that determine the magnitudes of equilibrium constants and their variation with temperature. Exercises 17.1a Use the equipartition theorem to estimate the constant-volume molar heat capacity of (a) I2, (b) CH4, (c) C6H6 in the gas phase at 25°C. 17.1b Use the equipartition theorem to estimate the constant-volume molar heat capacity of (a) O3, (b) C2H6, (c) CO2 in the gas phase at 25°C. 17.2a Estimate the values of γ = Cp/CV for gaseous ammonia and methane. Do this calculation with and without the vibrational contribution to the energy. Which is closer to the expected experimental value at 25°C? 17.2b Estimate the value of γ = Cp/CV for carbon dioxide. Do this calculation with and without the vibrational contribution to the energy. Which is closer to the expected experimental value at 25°C? 17.3a EstimatetherotationalpartitionfunctionofHClat(a)25°Cand(b)250°C. 17.3b Estimate the rotational partition function of O2 at (a) 25°C and (b) 250°C. 17.4a Give the symmetry number for each of the following molecules: (a) CO, (b) O2, (c) H2S, and (d) SiH4, (e) CHCl3. 17.4b Give the symmetry number for each of the following molecules: (a) CO2, (b) O3, (c) SO3, (d) SF6, and (e) Al2Cl6. 17.5a Calculate the rotational partition function of H2O at 298 K from its rotational constants 27.878 cm−1 , 14.509 cm−1 , and 9.287 cm−1 . Above what temperature is the high-temperature approximation valid to within 10 per cent of the true value? 17.5b Calculate the rotational partition function of SO2 at 298 K from its rotational constants 2.027 36 cm−1 , 0.344 17 cm−1 , and 0.293 535 cm−1 . Above what temperature is the high-temperature approximation valid to within 10 per cent of the true value? 17.6a From the results of Exercise 17.5a, calculate the rotational contribution to the molar entropy of gaseous water at 25°C. 17.6b From the results of Exercise 17.5b, calculate the rotational contribution to the molar entropy of sulfur dioxide at 25°C. 17.7a Calculate the rotational partition function of CH4 (a) by direct summation of the energy levels at 298 K and 500 K, and (b) by the hightemperature approximation. Take B = 5.2412 cm−1 . 17.7b Calculate the rotational partition function of CH3CN (a) by direct summation of the energy levels at 298 K and 500 K, and (b) by the hightemperature approximation. Take A = 5.28 cm−1 and B = 0.307 cm−1 . 17.8a The bond length of O2 is 120.75 pm. Use the high-temperature approximation to calculate the rotational partition function of the molecule at 300 K. 17.8b The NOF molecule is an asymmetric rotor with rotational constants 3.1752 cm−1 , 0.3951 cm−1 , and 0.3505 cm−1 . Calculate the rotational partition function of the molecule at (a) 25°C, (b) 100°C. 17.9a Plot the molar heat capacity of a collection of harmonic oscillators as a function of T/θV, and predict the vibrational heat capacity of ethyne at (a) 298 K, (b) 500 K. The normal modes (and their degeneracies in parentheses) occur at wavenumbers 612(2), 729(2), 1974, 3287, and 3374 cm−1 . 17.9b Plot the molar entropy of a collection of harmonic oscillators as a function of T/θV, and predict the standard molar entropy of ethyne at (a) 298 K, (b) 500 K. For data, see the preceding exercise. 17.10a A CO2 molecule is linear, and its vibrational wavenumbers are 1388.2 cm−1 , 667.4 cm−1 , and 2349.2 cm−1 , the last being doubly degenerate and the others non-degenerate. The rotational constant of the molecule is 0.3902 cm−1 . Calculate the rotational and vibrational contributions to the molar Gibbs energy at 298 K. 17.10b An O3 molecule is angular, and its vibrational wavenumbers are 1110 cm−1 , 705 cm−1 , and 1042 cm−1 . The rotational constants of the molecule are 3.553 cm−1 , 0.4452 cm−1 , and 0.3948 cm−1 . Calculate the rotational and vibrational contributions to the molar Gibbs energy at 298 K. 17.11a The ground level of Cl is 2 P3/2 and a 2 P1/2 level lies 881 cm−1 above it. Calculate the electronic contribution to the heat capacity of Cl atoms at (a) 500 K and (b) 900 K. 17.11b The first electronically excited state of O2 is 1 ∆g and lies 7918.1 cm−1 above the ground state, which is 3 Σg − . Calculate the electronic contribution to the molar Gibbs energy of O2 at 400 K. 17.12a The ground state of the Co2+ ion in CoSO4·7H2O may be regarded as 4 T9/2. The entropy of the solid at temperatures below 1 K is derived almost entirely from the electron spin. Estimate the molar entropy of the solid at these temperatures. 17.12b Estimate the contribution of the spin to the molar entropy of a solid sample of a d-metal complex with S = 5 –2. 17.13a Calculate the residual molar entropy of a solid in which the molecules can adopt (a) three, (b) five, (c) six orientations of equal energy at T = 0. 17.13b Suppose that the hexagonal molecule C6HnF6−n has a residual entropy on account of the similarity of the H and F atoms. Calculate the residual for each value of n. 17.14a Calculate the equilibrium constant of the reaction I2(g) 5 2 I(g) at 1000 K from the following data for I2: # = 214.36 cm−1 , B = 0.0373 cm−1 , De = 1.5422 eV. The ground state of the I atoms is 2 P3/2, implying fourfold degeneracy. 17.14b Calculate the value of K at 298 K for the gas-phase isotopic exchange reaction 2 79 Br81 Br 79 Br79 5 Br + 81 Br81 Br. The Br2 molecule has a nondegenerate ground state, with no other electronic states nearby. Base the calculation on the wavenumber of the vibration of 79 Br81 Br, which is 323.33 cm−1 . 618 17 STATISTICAL THERMODYNAMICS 2: APPLICATIONS Problems* Numerical problems 17.1 The NO molecule has a doubly degenerate electronic ground state and a doubly degenerate excited state at 121.1 cm−1 . Calculate the electronic contribution to the molar heat capacity of the molecule at (a) 50 K, (b) 298 K, and (c) 500 K. 17.2 Explore whether a magnetic field can influence the heat capacity of a paramagnetic molecule by calculating the electronic contribution to the heat capacity of an NO2 molecule in a magnetic field. Estimate the total constantvolume heat capacity using equipartition, and calculate the percentage change in heat capacity brought about by a 5.0 T magnetic field at (a) 50 K, (b) 298 K. 17.3 The energy levels of a CH3 group attached to a larger fragment are given by the expression for a particle on a ring, provided the group is rotating freely. What is the high-temperature contribution to the heat capacity and entropy of such a freely rotating group at 25°C? The moment of inertia of CH3 about its three-fold rotation axis (the axis that passes through the C atom and the centre of the equilateral triangle formed by the H atoms) is 5.341 × 10−47 kg m2 ). 17.4 Calculate the temperature dependence of the heat capacity of p-H2 (in which only rotational states with even values of J are populated) at low temperatures on the basis that its rotational levels J = 0 and J = 2 constitute a system that resembles a two-level system except for the degeneracy of the upper level. Use B = 60.864 cm−1 and sketch the heat capacity curve. The experimental heat capacity of p-H2 does in fact show a peak at low temperatures. 17.5 The pure rotational microwave spectrum of HCl has absorption lines at the following wavenumbers (in cm−1 ): 21.19, 42.37, 63.56, 84.75, 105.93, 127.12 148.31 169.49, 190.68, 211.87, 233.06, 254.24, 275.43, 296.62, 317.80, 338.99, 360.18, 381.36, 402.55, 423.74, 444.92, 466.11, 487.30, 508.48. Calculate the rotational partition function at 25°C by direct summation. 17.6 Calculate the standard molar entropy of N2(g) at 298 K from its rotational constant B = 1.9987 cm−1 and its vibrational wavenumber # = 2358 cm−1 . The thermochemical value is 192.1 J K−1 mol−1 . What does this suggest about the solid at T = 0? 17.7‡ J.G. Dojahn, E.C.M. Chen, and W.E. Wentworth (J. Phys. Chem. 100, 9649 (1996)) characterized the potential energy curves of the ground and electronic states of homonuclear diatomic halogen anions. The ground state of F2 − is 2 Σu + with a fundamental vibrational wavenumber of 450.0 cm−1 and equilibrium internuclear distance of 190.0 pm. The first two excited states are at 1.609 and 1.702 eV above the ground state. Compute the standard molar entropy of F2 − at 298 K. 17.8‡ In a spectroscopic study of buckminsterfullerene C60, F. Negri, G. Orlandi, and F. Zerbetto (J. Phys. Chem. 100, 10849 (1996)) reviewed the wavenumbers of all the vibrational modes of the molecule. The wavenumber for the single Au mode is 976 cm−1 ; wavenumbers for the four threefold degenerate T1u modes are 525, 578, 1180, and 1430 cm−1 ; wavenumbers for the five threefold degenerate T2u modes are 354, 715, 1037, 1190, and 1540 cm−1 ; wavenumbers for the six fourfold degenerate Gu modes are 345, 757, 776, 963, 1315, and 1410 cm−1 ; and wavenumbers for the seven fivefold degenerate Hu modes are 403, 525, 667, 738, 1215, 1342, and 1566 cm−1 . How many modes have a vibrational temperature θV below 1000 K? Estimate the molar constant-volume heat capacity of C60 at 1000 K, counting as active all modes with θV below this temperature. 17.9‡ Treat carbon monoxide as a perfect gas and apply equilibrium statistical thermodynamics to the study of its properties, as specified below, in the temperature range 100–1000 K at 1 bar. # = 2169.8 cm−1 , B =1.931 cm−1 , and D0 = 11.09 eV; neglect anharmonicity and centrifugal distortion. (a) Examine the probability distribution of molecules over available rotational and vibrational states. (b) Explore numerically the differences, if any, between the rotational molecular partition function as calculated with the discrete energy distribution and that calculated with the classical, continuous energy distribution. (c) Calculate the individual contributions to Um(T) − Um (100 K), CV,m(T), and Sm(T) − Sm(100 K) made by the translational, rotational, and vibrational degrees of freedom. 17.10 Calculate and plot as a function of temperature, in the range 300 K to 1000 K, the equilibrium constant for the reaction CD4(g) + HCl(g) 5 CHD3(g) + DCl(g) using the following data (numbers in parentheses are degeneracies): #(CHD3)/cm−1 = 2993(1), 2142(1), 1003(3), 1291(2), 1036(2); #(CD4)/cm−1 = 2109(1), 1092(2), 2259(3), 996(3); #(HCl)/cm−1 = 2991; #(DCl)/cm−1 = 2145; B(HCl)/cm−1 = 10.59; B(DCl)/cm−1 = 5.445; B(CHD3)/cm−1 = 3.28; A(CHD3)/cm−1 = 2.63, B(CD4)/cm−1 = 2.63. 17.11 The exchange of deuterium between acid and water is an important type of equilibrium, and we can examine it using spectroscopic data on the molecules. Calculate the equilibrium constant at (a) 298 K and (b) 800 K for the gas-phase exchange reaction H2O + DCl 5 HDO + HCl from the following data: #(H2O)/cm−1 = 3656.7, 1594.8, 3755.8; #(HDO)/cm−1 = 2726.7, 1402.2, 3707.5; A(H2O)/cm−1 = 27.88; B(H2O)/cm−1 = 14.51; C(H2O)/cm−1 = 9.29; A(HDO)/cm−1 = 23.38; B(HDO)/cm−1 = 9.102; C(HDO)/cm−1 = 6.417; B(HCl)/cm−1 = 10.59; B(DCl)/cm−1 = 5.449; #(HCl)/cm−1 = 2991; #(DCl)/cm−1 = 2145. Theoretical problems 17.12 Derive the Sackur–Tetrode equation for a monatomic gas confined to a two-dimensional surface, and hence derive an expression for the standard molar entropy of condensation to form a mobile surface film. 17.13‡ For H2 at very low temperatures, only translational motion contributes to the heat capacity. At temperatures above θR = hcB/k, the rotational contribution to the heat capacity becomes significant. At still higher temperatures, above θV = hν/k, the vibrations contribute. But at this latter temperature, dissociation of the molecule into the atoms must be considered. (a) Explain the origin of the expressions for θR and θV, and calculate their values for hydrogen. (b) Obtain an expression for the molar constant-pressure heat capacity of hydrogen at all temperatures taking into account the dissociation of hydrogen. (c) Make a plot of the molar constant-pressure heat capacity as a function of temperature in the high-temperature region where dissociation of the molecule is significant. 17.14 Derive expressions for the internal energy, heat capacity, entropy, Helmholtz energy, and Gibbs energy of a harmonic oscillator. Express the results in terms of the vibrational temperature, θV and plot graphs of each property against T/θV. 17.15 Suppose that an intermolecular potential has a hard-sphere core of radius r1 and a shallow attractive well of uniform depth ε out to a distance r2. Show, by using eqn 17.42 and the condition ε << kT, that such a model is approximately consistent with a van der Waals equation of state when b << Vm, and relate the van der Waals parameters and the Joule–Thomson coefficient to the parameters in this model. * Problems denoted with the symbol ‡ were supplied by Charles Trapp, Carmen Giunta, and Marshall Cady. PROBLEMS 619 17.16‡ (a) Show that the number of molecules in any given rotational state of a linear molecule is given by NJ = C(2J + 1)e−hcBJ(J+1)/kT , where C is independent of J. (b) Use this result to derive eqn 13.39 for the value of J of the most highly populated rotational level. (c) Estimate the temperature at which the spectrum of HCl shown in Fig. 13.44 was obtained. (d) What is the most highly populated level of a spherical rotor at a temperature T? 17.17 A more formal way of arriving at the value of the symmetry number is to note that σ is the order (the number of elements) of the rotational subgroup of the molecule, the point group of the molecule with all but the identity and the rotations removed. The rotational subgroup of H2O is {E, C2}, so σ = 2. The rotational subgroup of NH3 is {E, 2C3}, so σ = 3. This recipe makes it easy to find the symmetry numbers for more complicated molecules. The rotational subgroup of CH4 is obtained from the T character table as {E, 8C3, 3C2}, so σ = 12. For benzene, the rotational subgroup of D6h is {E, 2C6, 2C3, C2, 3C2′, 3C2″}, so σ = 12. (a) Estimate the rotational partition function of ethene at 25°C given that A = 4.828 cm−1 , B = 1.0012 cm−1 , and C = 0.8282 cm−1 . (b) Evaluate the rotational partition function of pyridine, C5H5N, at room temperature (A = 0.2014 cm−1 , B = 0.1936 cm−1 , C = 0.0987 cm−1 ). 17.18 Although expressions like ͗ε͘ = −d ln q/dβ are useful for formal manipulations in statistical thermodynamics, and for expressing thermodynamic functions in neat formulas, they are sometimes more trouble than they are worth in practical applications. When presented with a table of energy levels, it is often much more convenient to evaluate the following sums directly: q = ∑ j e−βεj ≥ = ∑ j βεje−βεj ” = ∑ j (βεj)2 e−βεj (a) Derive expressions for the internal energy, heat capacity, and entropy in terms of these three functions. (b) Apply the technique to the calculation of the electronic contribution to the constant-volume molar heat capacity of magnesium vapour at 5000 K using the following data: Term 1 S 3 P0 3 P1 3 P2 1 P1 3 S1 Degeneracy 1 1 3 5 3 3 #/cm−1 0 21 850 21 870 21 911 35 051 41 197 17.19 Show how the heat capacity of a linear rotor is related to the following sum: ζ(β) = ∑ J,J′ {ε(J) − ε(J′)}2 g(J)g(J′)e−β{ε(J)+ε(J′)} by C = 1 –2Nkβ2 ζ(β) where the ε(J) are the rotational energy levels and g(J) their degeneracies. Then go on to show graphically that the total contribution to the heat capacity of a linear rotor can be regarded as a sum of contributions due to transitions 0→1, 0→2, 1→2, 1→3, etc. In this way, construct Fig. 17.11 for the rotational heat capacities of a linear molecule. 17.20 Set up a calculation like that in Problem 17.19 to analyse the vibrational contribution to the heat capacity in terms of excitations between levels and illustrate your results graphically in terms of a diagram like that in Fig. 17.11. 17.21 Determine whether a magnetic field can influence the value of an equilibrium constant. Consider the equilibrium I2(g) 5 2 I(g) at 1000 K, and calculate the ratio of equilibrium constants K(B)/K, where K(B) is the equilibrium constant when a magnetic field B is present and removes the degeneracy of the four states of the 2 P3/2 level. Data on the species are given in Exercise 17.14a. The electronic g value of the atoms is 4 –3. Calculate the field required to change the equilibrium constant by 1 per cent. 1 q2 17.22 The heat capacity ratio of a gas determines the speed of sound in it through the formula cs = (γRT/M)1/2 , where γ = Cp/CV and M is the molar mass of the gas. Deduce an expression for the speed of sound in a perfect gas of (a) diatomic, (b) linear triatomic, (c) nonlinear triatomic molecules at high temperatures (with translation and rotation active). Estimate the speed of sound in air at 25°C. Applications: to biology, materials science, environmental science, and astrophysics 17.23 An average human DNA molecule has 5 × 108 binucleotides (rungs on the DNA ladder) of four different kinds. If each rung were a random choice of one of these four possibilities, what would be the residual entropy associated with this typical DNA molecule? 17.24 It is possible to write an approximate expression for the partition function of a protein molecule by including contributions from only two states: the native and denatured forms of the polymer. Proceeding with this crude model gives us insight into the contribution of denaturation to the heat capacity of a protein. It follows from Illustration 16.4 that the total energy of a system of N protein molecules is E = where ε is the energy separation between the denatured and native forms. (a) Show that the constant-volume molar heat capacity is CV,m = Hint. For two functions f and g, the quotient rule of differentiation states that d(f/g)/dx = (1/g)df/dx − (f/g2 )dg/dx. (b) Plot the variation of CV,m with temperature. (c) If the function CV,m(T) has a maximum or minimum, derive an expression for the temperature at which it occurs. 17.25‡ R. Viswanathan, R.W. Schmude, Jr., and K.A. Gingerich (J. Phys. Chem. 100, 10784 (1996)) studied thermodynamic properties of several boron–silicon gas-phase species experimentally and theoretically. These species can occur in the high-temperature chemical vapour deposition (CVD) of silicon-based semiconductors. Among the computations they reported was computation of the Gibbs energy of BSi(g) at several temperatures based on a 4 Σ− ground state with equilibrium internuclear distance of 190.5 pm and fundamental vibrational wavenumber of 772 cm−1 and a 2 P0 first excited level 8000 cm−1 above the ground level. Compute the standard molar Gibbs energy G7 m(2000 K) − G7 m(0). 17.26‡ The molecule Cl2O2, which is believed to participate in the seasonal depletion of ozone over Antarctica, has been studied by several means. M. Birk, R.R. Friedl, E.A. Cohen, H.M. Pickett, and S.P. Sander (J. Chem. Phys. 91, 6588 (1989)) report its rotational constants (actually cB) as 13 109.4, 2409.8, and 2139.7 MHz. They also report that its rotational spectrum indicates a molecule with a symmetry number of 2. J. Jacobs, M. Kronberg, H.S.P. Möller, and H. Willner (J. Amer. Chem. Soc. 116, 1106 (1994)) report its vibrational wavenumbers as 753, 542, 310, 127, 646, and 419 cm−1 . Compute G7 m(200 K) − G7 m(0) of Cl2O2. 17.27‡ J. Hutter, H.P. Lüthi, and F. Diederich (J. Amer. Chem. Soc. 116, 750 (1994)) examined the geometric and vibrational structure of several carbon molecules of formula Cn. Given that the ground state of C3, a molecule found in interstellar space and in flames, is an angular singlet with moments of inertia 39.340, 39.032, and 0.3082 u Å2 (where 1 Å = 10−10 m) and with vibrational wavenumbers of 63.4, 1224.5, and 2040 cm−1 , compute G7 m(10.00 K) − G7 m(0) and G7 m(1000 K) − G7 m(0) for C3. R(εm/RT)2 e−εm/RT (1 + e−εm/RT )2 Nεe−ε/kT 1 + e−ε/kT Molecular interactions In this chapter we examine molecular interactions in gases and liquids and interpret them in terms of electric properties of molecules, such as electric dipole moments and polarizabilities. All these properties reflect the degree to which the nuclei of atoms exert control over the electrons in a molecule, either by causing electrons to accumulate in particular regions, or by permitting them to respond more or less strongly to the effects of external electric fields. Molecular interactions are responsible for the unique properties of substances as simple as water and as complex as polymers. We begin our examination of molecular interactions by describing the electric properties of molecules, which may be interpreted in terms of concepts in electronic structure introduced in Chapter 11. We shall see that small imbalances of charge distributions in molecules allow them to interact with one another and with externally applied fields. One result of this interaction is the cohesion of molecules to form the bulk phases of matter. These interactions are also important for understanding the shapes adopted by biological and synthetic macromolecules, as we shall see in Chapter 19. The interaction between ions is treated in Chapter 5 (for solutions) and Chapter 20 (for solids). Electric properties of molecules Many of the electric properties of molecules can be traced to the competing influences of nuclei with different charges or the competition between the control exercised by a nucleus and the influence of an externally applied field. The former competition may result in an electric dipole moment. The latter may result in properties such as refractive index and optical activity. 18.1 Electric dipole moments An electric dipole consists of two electric charges +q and −q separated by a distance R. This arrangement of charges is represented by a vector m (1). The magnitude of m is µ = qR and, although the SI unit of dipole moment is coulomb metre (C m), it is still commonly reported in the non-SI unit debye, D, named after Peter Debye, a pioneer in the study of dipole moments of molecules, where 1 D = 3.335 64 × 10−30 C m (18.1) The dipole moment of a pair of charges +e and −e separated by 100 pm is 1.6 × 10−29 C m, corresponding to 4.8 D. Dipole moments of small molecules are typically about 1 D. The conversion factor in eqn 18.1 stems from the original definition of the debye in terms of c.g.s. units: 1 D is the dipole moment of two equal and opposite charges of magnitude 1 e.s.u. separated by 1 Å. Electric properties of molecules 18.1 Electric dipole moments 18.2 Polarizabilities 18.3 Relative permittivities Interactions between molecules 18.4 Interactions between dipoles 18.5 Repulsive and total interactions I18.1 Impact on medicine: Molecular recognition and drug design Gases and liquids 18.6 Molecular interactions in gases 18.7 The liquid–vapour interface 18.8 Condensation Checklist of key ideas Further reading Further information 18.1: The dipole–dipole interaction Further information 18.2: The basic principles of molecular beams Discussion questions Exercises Problems 18 18.1 ELECTRIC DIPOLE MOMENTS 621 (a) Polar molecules A polar molecule is a molecule with a permanent electric dipole moment. The permanent dipole moment stems from the partial charges on the atoms in the molecule that arise from differences in electronegativity or other features of bonding (Section 11.6). Nonpolar molecules acquire an induced dipole moment in an electric field on account of the distortion the field causes in their electronic distributions and nuclear positions; however, this induced moment is only temporary, and disappears as soon as the perturbing field is removed. Polar molecules also have their existing dipole moments temporarily modified by an applied field. The Stark effect (Section 13.5) is used to measure the electric dipole moments of molecules for which a rotational spectrum can be observed. In many cases microwave spectroscopy cannot be used because the sample is not volatile, decomposes on vaporization, or consists of molecules that are so complex that their rotational spectra cannot be interpreted. In such cases the dipole moment may be obtained by measurements on a liquid or solid bulk sample using a method explained later. Computational software is now widely available, and typically computes electric dipole moments by assessing the electron density at each point in the molecule and its coordinates relative to the centroid of the molecule; however, it is still important to be able to formulate simple models of the origin of these moments and to understand how they arise. The following paragraphs focus on this aspect. All heteronuclear diatomic molecules are polar, and typical values of µ include 1.08 D for HCl and 0.42 D for HI (Table 18.1). Molecular symmetry is of the greatest importance in deciding whether a polyatomic molecule is polar or not. Indeed, molecular symmetry is more important than the question of whether or not the atoms in the molecule belong to the same element. Homonuclear polyatomic molecules may be polar if they have low symmetry and the atoms are in inequivalent positions. For instance, the angular molecule ozone, O3 (2), is homonuclear; however, it is polar because the central O atom is different from the outer two (it is bonded to two atoms, they are bonded only to one); moreover, the dipole moments associated with each bond make an angle to each other and do not cancel. Heteronuclear polyatomic molecules may be nonpolar if they have high symmetry, because individual bond dipoles may then cancel. The heteronuclear linear triatomic molecule CO2, for example, is nonpolar because, although there are partial charges on all three atoms, the dipole moment associated with the OC bond points in the opposite direction to the dipole moment associated with the CO bond, and the two cancel (3). To a first approximation, it is possible to resolve the dipole moment of a polyatomic molecule into contributions from various groups of atoms in the molecule and the directions in which these individual contributions lie (Fig. 18.1). Thus, Comment 18.1 In elementary chemistry, an electric dipole moment is represented by the arrow ( added to the Lewis structure for the molecule, with the + marking the positive end. Note that the direction of the arrow is opposite to that of µ. –q q R m 1 Electric dipole Synoptic table 18.1* Dipole moments (µ) and polarizability volumes (α′) m/D a¢/(10−30 m3 ) CCl4 0 10.5 H2 0 0.819 H2O 1.85 1.48 HCl 1.08 2.63 HI 0.42 5.45 * More values are given in the Data section. (a) 1.57 Dobs = (b) 0 0 obs calc = = (c) 2.25 D 2.7 D obs calc = = (d) 1.48 D 1.6 D obs calc = = C2v C2v C2v D2h m m m m m m m Fig. 18.1 The resultant dipole moments (pale yellow) of the dichlorobenzene isomers (b to d) can be obtained approximately by vectorial addition of two chlorobenzene dipole moments (1.57 D), purple. + m 2 Ozone, O3 d +d -d-d 3 Carbon dioxide, CO2 +d -d-d +d 622 18 MOLECULAR INTERACTIONS Comment 18.3 In three dimensions, a vector m has components µx, µy, and µz along the x-, y-, and z-axes, respectively, as shown in the illustration. The direction of each of the components is denoted with a plus sign or minus sign. For example, if µx = −1.0 D, the x-component of the vector µ has a magnitude of 1.0 D and points in the −x direction. z m m xm ym q 1 m 4 Addition of dipole moments m 2m Comment 18.2 Operations involving vectors are described in Appendix 2, where eqn 18.2 is also derived. Table 18.2 Partial charges in polypeptides Atom Partial charge/e C(=O) +0.45 C(-CO) +0.06 H(-C) +0.02 H(-N) +0.18 H(-O) +0.42 N –0.36 O –0.38 H N C O (182, 87, 0)(132, 0, 0) (0, 0, 0) ( 62, 107, 0)- 5 Amide group 1,4-dichlorobenzene is nonpolar by symmetry on account of the cancellation of two equalbutopposingC-Clmoments(exactlyasincarbondioxide).1,2-Dichlorobenzene, however, has a dipole moment which is approximately the resultant of two chlorobenzene dipole moments arranged at 60° to each other. This technique of ‘vector addition’ can be applied with fair success to other series of related molecules, and the resultant µres of two dipole moments µ1 and µ2 that make an angle θ to each other (4) is approximately µres ≈ (µ1 2 + µ2 2 + 2µ1µ2 cos θ)1/2 (18.2a) When the two dipole moments have the same magnitude (as in the dichlorobenzenes), this equation simplifies to µres ≈ 2µ1 cos 1 –2θ (18.2b) Self-test 18.1 Estimate the ratio of the electric dipole moments of ortho (1,2-) and meta (1,3-) disubstituted benzenes. [µ(ortho)/µ(meta) = 1.7] A better approach to the calculation of dipole moments is to take into account the locations and magnitudes of the partial charges on all the atoms. These partial charges are included in the output of many molecular structure software packages. To calculate the x-component, for instance, we need to know the partial charge on each atom and the atom’s x-coordinate relative to a point in the molecule and form the sum µx = ∑ J qJxJ (18.3a) Here qJ is the partial charge of atom J, xJ is the x-coordinate of atom J, and the sum is over all the atoms in the molecule. Analogous expressions are used for the y- and z-components. For an electrically neutral molecule, the origin of the coordinates is arbitrary, so it is best chosen to simplify the measurements. In common with all vectors, the magnitude of m is related to the three components µx, µy, and µz by µ = (µx 2 + µy 2 + µz 2 )1/2 (18.3b) Example 18.1 Calculating a molecular dipole moment Estimate the electric dipole moment of the amide group shown in (5) by using the partial charges (as multiples of e) in Table 18.2 and the locations of the atoms shown. Method We use eqn 18.3a to calculate each of the components of the dipole moment and then eqn 18.3b to assemble the three components into the magnitude of the dipole moment. Note that the partial charges are multiples of the fundamental charge, e = 1.609 × 10−19 C. Answer The expression for µx is µx = (−0.36e) × (132 pm) + (0.45e) × (0 pm) + (0.18e) × (182 pm) + (−0.38e) × (−62.0 pm) = 8.8e pm = 8.8 × (1.609 × 10−19 C) × (10−12 m) = 1.4 × 10−30 C m 18.1 ELECTRIC DIPOLE MOMENTS 623 (182, 87,0) (132,0,0) H N C O (0,0,0) ( 62,1 07,0) +0.18 0.36 +0.45 0.38 m 6 7 C H H O –0.38 +0.18+0.18 (0,118,0) (0,0,0) (–94,–61,0) (94,–61,0) corresponding to µx = 0.42 D. The expression for µy is: µy = (−0.36e) × (0 pm) + (0.45e) × (0 pm) + (0.18e) × (−86.6 pm) + (−0.38e) × (107 pm) = −56e pm = −9.1 × 10−30 C m It follows that µy = −2.7 D. Therefore, because µz = 0, µ = {(0.42 D)2 + (−2.7 D)2 }1/2 = 2.7 D We can find the orientation of the dipole moment by arranging an arrow of length 2.7 units of length to have x, y, and z components of 0.42, −2.7, and 0 units; the orientation is superimposed on (6). Self-test 18.2 Calculate the electric dipole moment of formaldehyde, using the information in (7). [−3.2 D] (b) Polarization The polarization, P, of a sample is the electric dipole moment density, the mean electric dipole moment of the molecules, ͗µ͘, multiplied by the number density, N : P = ͗µ͘N (18.4) In the following pages we refer to the sample as a dielectric, by which is meant a polarizable, nonconducting medium. The polarization of an isotropic fluid sample is zero in the absence of an applied field because the molecules adopt random orientations, so ͗µ͘ = 0. In the presence of a field, the dipoles become partially aligned because some orientations have lower energies than others. As a result, the electric dipole moment density is nonzero. We show in the Justification below that, at a temperature T ͗µz͘ = (18.5) where z is the direction of the applied field E. Moreover, as we shall see, there is an additional contribution from the dipole moment induced by the field. Justification 18.1 The thermally averaged dipole moment The probability dp that a dipole has an orientation in the range θ to θ + dθ is given by the Boltzmann distribution (Section 16.1b), which in this case is dp = where E(θ) is the energy of the dipole in the field: E(θ) = −µE cos θ, with 0 ≤ θ ≤ π. The average value of the component of the dipole moment parallel to the applied electric field is therefore ͗µz͘ = Ύµcosθdp = µΎcosθdp = µΎ π 0 excosθ cosθsinθ dθ Ύ π 0 excosθ sinθ dθ e−E(θ)/kT sin θdθ Ύ π 0 e−E(θ)/kT sin θdθ µ2 E 3kT 624 18 MOLECULAR INTERACTIONS with x = µE/kT. The integral takes on a simpler appearance when we write y = cos θ and note that dy = −sin θ dθ. ͗µz͘ = At this point we use Ύ 1 −1 exy dy = Ύ 1 −1 yexy dy = − It is now straightforward algebra to combine these two results and to obtain ͗µz͘ = µL(x) L(x) = − x = (18.6) L(x) is called the Langevin function. Under most circumstances, x is very small (for example, if µ = 1 D and T = 300 K, then x exceeds 0.01 only if the field strength exceeds 100 kV cm−1 , and most measurements are done at much lower strengths). When x << 1, the exponentials in the Langevin function can be expanded, and the largest term that survives is L(x) = 1–3x + · · · (18.7) Therefore, the average molecular dipole moment is given by eqn 18.6. 18.2 Polarizabilities An applied electric field can distort a molecule as well as align its permanent electric dipole moment. The induced dipole moment, µ*, is generally proportional to the field strength, E, and we write µ* = αE (18.8) (See Section 20.10 for exceptions to eqn 18.8.) The constant of proportionality α is the polarizability of the molecule. The greater the polarizability, the larger is the induced dipole moment for a given applied field. In a formal treatment, we should use vector quantities and allow for the possibility that the induced dipole moment might not lie parallel to the applied field, but for simplicity we discuss polarizabilities in terms of (scalar) magnitudes. (a) Polarizability volumes Polarizability has the units (coulomb metre)2 per joule (C2 m2 J−1 ). That collection of units is awkward, so α is often expressed as a polarizability volume, α′, by using the relation α′ = [18.9] where ε0 is the vacuum permittivity. Because the units of 4πε0 are coulomb-squared per joule per metre (C2 J−1 m−1 ), it follows that α′ has the dimensions of volume (hence its name). Polarizability volumes are similar in magnitude to actual molecular volumes (of the order of 10−30 m3 , 10−3 nm3 , 1 Å3 ). α 4πε0 µE kT 1 x ex + e−x ex − e−x ex − e−x x2 ex + e−x x ex − e−x x µΎ 1 −1 yexy dy Ύ 1 −1 exy dy Comment 18.4 When x is small, it is possible to simplify expressions by using the expansion ex = 1 + x + 1–2x2 + 1–6x3 + · · · ; it is important when developing approximations that all terms of the same order are retained because low-order terms might cancel. Comment 18.5 When using older compilations of data, it is useful to note that polarizability volumes have the same numerical values as the ‘polarizabilities’ reported using c.g.s. electrical units, so the tabulated values previously called ‘polarizabilities’ can be used directly. 18.2 POLARIZABILITIES 625 Some experimental polarizability volumes of molecules are given in Table 18.1. As shown in the Justification below, polarizability volumes correlate with the HOMO– LUMO separations in atoms and molecules. The electron distribution can be distorted readily if the LUMO lies close to the HOMO in energy, so the polarizability is then large. If the LUMO lies high above the HOMO, an applied field cannot perturb the electron distribution significantly, and the polarizability is low. Molecules with small HOMO–LUMO gaps are typically large, with numerous electrons. Justification 18.2 Polarizabilities and molecular structures When an electric field is increased by dE, the energy of a molecule changes by −µdE, and if the molecule is polarizable, we interpret µ as µ* (eqn 18.8). Therefore, the change in energy when the field is increased from 0 to E is ∆E = −Ύ E 0 µ*dE = −Ύ E 0 αE dE = − 1 –2αE2 The contribution to the hamiltonian when a dipole moment is exposed to an electric field E in the z-direction is H(1) = −µzE Comparison of these two expressions suggests that we should use second-order perturbation theory to calculate the energy of the system in the presence of the field, because then we shall obtain an expression proportional toE2 . According to eqn 9.65b, the second-order contribution to the energy is E(2) = ∑ n ′ 2 = E2 ∑ n ′ 2 b= E2 ∑ n ′ where µz,0n is the transition electric dipole moment in the z-direction (eqn 9.70). By comparing the two expressions for the energy, we conclude that the polarizability of the molecule in the z-direction is α = 2∑ n ′ (18.10) The content of eqn 18.10 can be appreciated by approximating the excitation energies by a mean value ∆E (an indication of the HOMO–LUMO separation), and supposing that the most important transition dipole moment is approximately equal to the charge of an electron multiplied by the radius, R, of the molecule. Then α ≈ This expression shows that α increases with the size of the molecule and with the ease with which it can be excited (the smaller the value of ∆E). If the excitation energy is approximated by the energy needed to remove an electron to infinity from a distance R from a single positive charge, we can write ∆E ≈ e2 /4πε0R. When this expression is substituted into the equation above, both sides are divided by 4πε0, and the factor of 2 ignored in this approximation, we obtain α′ ≈ R3 , which is of the same order of magnitude as the molecular volume. For most molecules, the polarizability is anisotropic, by which is meant that its value depends on the orientation of the molecule relative to the field. The polarizability volume of benzene when the field is applied perpendicular to the ring is 0.0067 nm3 2e2 R2 ∆E |µz,0n|2 En (0) − E0 (0) |µz,0n|2 E0 (0) − En (0) Ύψn*µzψ0dτ E0 (0) − En (0) Ύψn*H(1) ψ0dτ E0 (0) − En (0) 626 18 MOLECULAR INTERACTIONS and it is 0.0123 nm3 when the field is applied in the plane of the ring. The anisotropy of the polarizability determines whether a molecule is rotationally Raman active (Section 13.7). (b) Polarization at high frequencies When the applied field changes direction slowly, the permanent dipole moment has time to reorientate—the whole molecule rotates into a new direction—and follow the field. However, when the frequency of the field is high, a molecule cannot change direction fast enough to follow the change in direction of the applied field and the dipole moment then makes no contribution to the polarization of the sample. Because a molecule takes about 1 ps to turn through about 1 radian in a fluid, the loss of this contribution to the polarization occurs when measurements are made at frequencies greater than about 1011 Hz (in the microwave region). We say that the orientation polarization, the polarization arising from the permanent dipole moments, is lost at such high frequencies. The next contribution to the polarization to be lost as the frequency is raised is the distortion polarization, the polarization that arises from the distortion of the positions of the nuclei by the applied field. The molecule is bent and stretched by the applied field, and the molecular dipole moment changes accordingly. The time taken for a molecule to bend is approximately the inverse of the molecular vibrational frequency, so the distortion polarization disappears when the frequency of the radiation is increased through the infrared. The disappearance of polarization occurs in stages: as shown in the Justification below, each successive stage occurs as the incident frequency rises above the frequency of a particular mode of vibration. At even higher frequencies, in the visible region, only the electrons are mobile enough to respond to the rapidly changing direction of the applied field. The polarization that remains is now due entirely to the distortion of the electron distribution, and the surviving contribution to the molecular polarizability is called the electronic polarizability. Justification 18.3 The frequency-dependence of polarizabilities The quantum mechanical expression for the polarizability of a molecule in the presence of an electric field that is oscillating at a frequency ω in the z-direction is obtained by using time-dependent perturbation theory (Further information 9.2) and is α(ω) = ∑ n ′ (18.11) The quantities in this expression (which is valid provided that ω is not close to ωn0) are the same as those in the previous Justification, with $ωn0 = E n (0) − E 0 (0) . As ω → 0, the equation reduces to eqn 18.10 for the static polarizability. As ω becomes very high (and much higher than any excitation frequency of the molecule so that the ω2 n0 in the denominator can be ignored), the polarizability becomes α(ω) = − ∑ n ωn0 |µ0n|2 → 0 as ω → ∞ That is, when the incident frequency is much higher than any excitation frequency, the polarizability becomes zero. The argument applies to each type of excitation, vibrational as well as electronic, and accounts for the successive decreases in polarizability as the frequency is increased. 2 $ω2 ωn0|µz,0n|2 ω2 n0 − ω2 2 $ 18.3 RELATIVE PERMITTIVITIES 627 18.3 Relative permittivities When two charges q1 and q2 are separated by a distance r in a vacuum, the potential energy of their interaction is (see Appendix 3): V = (18.12a) When the same two charges are immersed in a medium (such as air or a liquid), their potential energy is reduced to V = (18.12b) where ε is the permittivity of the medium. The permittivity is normally expressed in terms of the dimensionless relative permittivity, εr, (formerly and still widely called the dielectric constant) of the medium: εr = [18.13] The relative permittivity can have a very significant effect on the strength of the interactions between ions in solution. For instance, water has a relative permittivity of 78 at 25°C, so the interionic Coulombic interaction energy is reduced by nearly two orders of magnitude from its vacuum value. Some of the consequences of this reduction for electrolyte solutions were explored in Chapter 5. The relative permittivity of a substance is large if its molecules are polar or highly polarizable. The quantitative relation between the relative permittivity and the electric properties of the molecules is obtained by considering the polarization of a medium, and is expressed by the Debye equation (for the derivation of this and the following equations, see Further reading): = (18.14) where ρ is the mass density of the sample, M is the molar mass of the molecules, and Pm is the molar polarization, which is defined as Pm = α + [18.15] The term µ2 /3kT stems from the thermal averaging of the electric dipole moment in the presence of the applied field (eqn 18.5). The corresponding expression without the contribution from the permanent dipole moment is called the Clausius–Mossotti equation: = (18.16) The Clausius–Mossotti equation is used when there is no contribution from permanent electric dipole moments to the polarization, either because the molecules are nonpolar or because the frequency of the applied field is so high that the molecules cannot orientate quickly enough to follow the change in direction of the field. ρNAα 3Mε0 εr − 1 εr + 2 D F µ2 3kT A C NA 3ε0 ρPm M εr − 1 εr + 2 ε ε0 q1q2 4πεr q1q2 4πε0r 628 18 MOLECULAR INTERACTIONS O 8 Camphor 2 3 4 (10 K)/3 T Pm/(cmmol) 31 106 110 114 118 122 Fig. 18.2 The plot of Pm/(cm3 mol−1 ) against (103 K)/T used in Example 18.2 for the determination of the polarizability and dipole moment of camphor. Example 18.2 Determining dipole moment and polarizability The relative permittivity of a substance is measured by comparing the capacitance of a capacitor with and without the sample present (C and C0, respectively) and using εr = C/C0. The relative permittivity of camphor (8) was measured at a series of temperatures with the results given below. Determine the dipole moment and the polarizability volume of the molecule. θ/°C ρ/(g cm−3 ) εr 0 0.99 12.5 20 0.99 11.4 40 0.99 10.8 60 0.99 10.0 80 0.99 9.50 100 0.99 8.90 120 0.97 8.10 140 0.96 7.60 160 0.95 7.11 200 0.91 6.21 Method Equation 18.14 implies that the polarizability and permanent electric dipole moment of the molecules in a sample can be determined by measuring εr at a series of temperatures, calculating Pm, and plotting it against 1/T. The slope of the graph is NAµ2 /9ε0k and its intercept at 1/T = 0 is NAα/3ε0. We need to calculate (εr − 1)/(εr + 2) at each temperature, and then multiply by M/ρ to form Pm. Answer For camphor, M = 152.23 g mol−1 . We can therefore use the data to draw up the following table: θ/°C (103 K)/T εr (εr − 1)/(εr + 2) Pm /(cm3 mol−1 ) 0 3.66 12.5 0.793 122 20 3.41 11.4 0.776 119 40 3.19 10.8 0.766 118 60 3.00 10.0 0.750 115 80 2.83 9.50 0.739 114 100 2.68 8.90 0.725 111 120 2.54 8.10 0.703 110 140 2.42 7.60 0.688 109 160 2.31 7.11 0.670 107 200 2.11 6.21 0.634 106 The points are plotted in Fig. 18.2. The intercept lies at 82.7, so α′ = 3.3 × 10−23 cm3 . The slope is 10.9, so µ = 4.46 × 10−30 C m, corresponding to 1.34 D. Because the Debye equation describes molecules that are free to rotate, the data show that camphor, which does not melt until 175°C, is rotating even in the solid. It is an approximately spherical molecule. Self-test 18.3 The relative permittivity of chlorobenzene is 5.71 at 20°C and 5.62 at 25°C. Assuming a constant density (1.11 g cm−3 ), estimate its polarizability volume and dipole moment. [1.4 × 10−23 cm3 , 1.2 D] 18.4 INTERACTIONS BETWEEN DIPOLES 629 The Maxwell equations that describe the properties of electromagnetic radiation (see Further reading) relate the refractive index at a (visible or ultraviolet) specified wavelength to the relative permittivity at that frequency: nr = εr 1/2 (18.17) Therefore, the molar polarization, Pm, and the molecular polarizability, α, can be measured at frequencies typical of visible light (about 1015 to 1016 Hz) by measuring the refractive index of the sample and using the Clausius–Mossotti equation. Interactions between molecules AvanderWaalsinteractionis the attractive interaction between closed-shell molecules that depends on the distance between the molecules as 1/r6 . In addition, there are interactions between ions and the partial charges of polar molecules and repulsive interactions that prevent the complete collapse of matter to nuclear densities. The repulsive interactions arise from Coulombic repulsions and, indirectly, from the Pauli principle and the exclusion of electrons from regions of space where the orbitals of neighbouring species overlap. 18.4 Interactions between dipoles Most of the discussion in this section is based on the Coulombic potential energy of interaction between two charges (eqn 18.12a). We can easily adapt this expression to find the potential energy of a point charge and a dipole and to extend it to the interaction between two dipoles. (a) The potential energy of interaction We show in the Justification below that the potential energy of interaction between a point dipole µ1 = q1l and the point charge q2 in the arrangement shown in (9) is V = − (18.18) With µ in coulomb metres, q2 in coulombs, and r in metres, V is obtained in joules. A point dipole is a dipole in which the separation between the charges is much smaller than the distance at which the dipole is being observed, l << r. The potential energy rises towards zero (the value at infinite separation of the charge and the dipole) more rapidly (as 1/r2 ) than that between two point charges (which varies as 1/r) because, from the viewpoint of the point charge, the partial charges of the dipole seem to merge and cancel as the distance r increases (Fig. 18.3). Justification 18.4 The interaction between a point charge and a point dipole The sum of the potential energies of repulsion between like charges and attraction between opposite charges in the orientation shown in (9) is V = − + = − + where x = l/2r. Because l << r for a point dipole, this expression can be simplified by expanding the terms in x and retaining only the leading term: V = {−(1 + x + · · · ) + (1 − x + · · · )} ≈ − = − With µ1 = q1l, this expression becomes eqn 18.18. This expression should be multiplied by cos θ when the point charge lies at an angle θ to the axis of the dipole. q1q2l 4πε0r2 2xq1q2 4πε0r q1q2 4πε0r D E F 1 1 + x 1 1 − x A B C q1q2 4πε0r D E F q1q2 r + 1–2l q1q2 r − 1–2l A B C 1 4πε0 µ1q2 4πε0r2 Comment 18.6 The refractive index, nr, of the medium is the ratio of the speed of light in a vacuum, c, to its speed c¢ in the medium: nr = c/c′. A beam of light changes direction (‘bends’) when it passes from a region of one refractive index to a region with a different refractive index. See Appendix 3 for details. l r q1 –q1 q2 9 Fig. 18.3 There are two contributions to the diminishing field of an electric dipole with distance (here seen from the side). The potentials of the charges decrease (shown here by a fading intensity) and the two charges appear to merge, so their combined effect approaches zero more rapidly than by the distance effect alone. 630 18 MOLECULAR INTERACTIONS Comment 18.7 The following expansions are often useful: = 1 − x + x2 − · · · = 1 + x + x2 + · · · 1 1 − x 1 1 + x l l r q1 -q1 -q2q2 10 Table 18.3 Multipole interaction potential energies Distance dependence Typical energy/ Interaction type of potential energy (kJ mol−1 ) Comment Ion–ion 1/r 250 Only between ions* Ion–dipole 1/r2 15 Dipole–dipole 1/r3 2 Between stationary polar molecules 1/r6 0.6 Between rotating polar molecules London (dispersion) 1/r6 2 Between all types of molecules The energy of a hydrogen bond A-H···B is typically 20 kJ mol−l and occurs on contact for A, B = O, N, or F. * Electrolyte solutions are treated in Chapter 5, ionic solids in Chapter 20. r q1 -q1 -q2q2 11 Monopole Dipole Quadrupole Quadrupole Octupole Octupole Fig. 18.4 Typical charge arrays corresponding to electric multipoles. The field arising from an arbitrary finite charge distribution can be expressed as the superposition of the fields arising from a superposition of multipoles. Example 18.3 Calculating the interaction energy of two dipoles Calculate the potential energy of interaction of two dipoles in the arrangement shown in (10) when their separation is r. Method We proceed in exactly the same way as in Justification 18.4, but now the total interaction energy is the sum of four pairwise terms, two attractions between opposite charges, which contribute negative terms to the potential energy, and two repulsions between like charges, which contribute positive terms. Answer The sum of the four contributions is V = − + + − = − − 2 + with x = l/r. As before, provided l << r we can expand the two terms in x and retain only the first surviving term, which is equal to 2x2 . This step results in the expression V = − Therefore, because µ1 = q1l and µ2 = q2l, the potential energy of interaction in the alignment shown in the illustration is V = − This interaction energy approaches zero more rapidly (as 1/r3 ) than for the previous case: now both interacting entities appear neutral to each other at large separations. See Further information 18.1 for the general expression. Self-test 18.4 Derive an expression for the potential energy when the dipoles are in the arrangement shown in (11). [V = µ1µ2/4πε0r3 ] Table 18.3 summarizes the various expressions for the interaction of charges and dipoles. It is quite easy to extend the formulas given there to obtain expressions for the energy of interaction of higher multipoles, or arrays of point charges (Fig. 18.4). Specifically, an n-pole is an array of point charges with an n-pole moment but no lower moment. Thus, a monopole (n = 1) is a point charge, and the monopole moment is what we normally call the overall charge. A dipole (n = 2), as we have seen, is an array µ1µ2 2πε0r3 2xq1q2 4πε0r D F 1 1 − x 1 1 + x A C q1q2 4πε0r D F q1q2 r − l q1q2 r q1q2 r q1q2 r + l A C 1 4πε0 18.4 INTERACTIONS BETWEEN DIPOLES 631 of charges that has no monopole moment (no net charge). A quadrupole (n = 3) consists of an array of point charges that has neither net charge nor dipole moment (as for CO2 molecules, 3). An octupole (n = 4) consists of an array of point charges that sum to zero and which has neither a dipole moment nor a quadrupole moment (as for CH4 molecules, 12). The feature to remember is that the interaction energy falls off more rapidly the higher the order of the multipole. For the interaction of an n-pole with an m-pole, the potential energy varies with distance as V ∝ (18.19) The reason for the even steeper decrease with distance is the same as before: the array of charges appears to blend together into neutrality more rapidly with distance the higher the number of individual charges that contribute to the multipole. Note that a given molecule may have a charge distribution that corresponds to a superposition of several different multipoles. (b) The electric field The same kind of argument as that used to derive expressions for the potential energy can be used to establish the distance dependence of the strength of the electric field generated by a dipole. We shall need this expression when we calculate the dipole moment induced in one molecule by another. The starting point for the calculation is the strength of the electric field generated by a point electric charge: E = (18.20) The field generated by a dipole is the sum of the fields generated by each partial charge. For the point-dipole arrangement shown in Fig. 18.5, the same procedure that was used to derive the potential energy gives E = (18.21) The electric field of a multipole (in this case a dipole) decreases more rapidly with distance (as 1/r3 for a dipole) than a monopole (a point charge). (c) Dipole–dipole interactions The potential energy of interaction between two polar molecules is a complicated function of their relative orientation. When the two dipoles are parallel (as in 13), the potential energy is simply (see Further information 18.1) V = f(θ) = 1 − 3 cos2 θ (18.22) This expression applies to polar molecules in a fixed, parallel, orientation in a solid. In a fluid of freely rotating molecules, the interaction between dipoles averages to zero because f(θ) changes sign as the orientation changes, and its average value is zero. Physically, the like partial charges of two freely rotating molecules are close together as much as the two opposite charges, and the repulsion of the former is cancelled by the attraction of the latter. The interaction energy of two freely rotating dipoles is zero. However, because their mutual potential energy depends on their relative orientation, the molecules do not in fact rotate completely freely, even in a gas. In fact, the lower energy orientations are µ1µ2 f(θ) 4πε0r3 µ 2πε0r3 q 4πε0r2 1 rn+m−1 +d +d +d +d –d –d –d –d 12 CH4 Comment 18.8 The electric field is actually a vector, and we cannot simply add and subtract magnitudes without taking into account the directions of the fields. In the cases we consider, this will not be a complication because the two charges of the dipoles will be collinear and give rise to fields in the same direction. Be careful, though, with more general arrangements of charges. Resultant m Fig. 18.5 The electric field of a dipole is the sum of the opposing fields from the positive and negative charges, each of which is proportional to 1/r2 . The difference, the net field, is proportional to 1/r3 . r q1 -q1 -q2q2 q 13 Comment 18.9 The average (or mean value) of a function f(x) over the range from x = a to x = b is ͗ f ͘ = Ύ b a f(x)dx The volume element in polar coordinates is proportional to sin θ dθ, and θ ranges from 0 to π. Therefore the average value of (1 − 3 cos2 θ) is (1/π)Ύ π 0 (1 − 3 cos2 θ) sin θ dθ = 0. 1 b − a 632 18 MOLECULAR INTERACTIONS marginally favoured, so there is a nonzero average interaction between polar molecules. We show in the following Justification that the average potential energy of two rotating molecules that are separated by a distance r is ͗V͘ = − C = (18.23) This expression describes the Keesominteraction, and is the first of the contributions to the van der Waals interaction. Justification 18.5 The Keesom interaction The detailed calculation of the Keesom interaction energy is quite complicated, but the form of the final answer can be constructed quite simply. First, we note that the average interaction energy of two polar molecules rotating at a fixed separation r is given by ͗V͘ = where ͗ f ͘ now includes a weighting factor in the averaging that is equal to the probability that a particular orientation will be adopted. This probability is given by the Boltzmann distribution p ∝ e−E/kT , with E interpreted as the potential energy of interaction of the two dipoles in that orientation. That is, p ∝ e−V/kT V = When the potential energy of interaction of the two dipoles is very small compared with the energy of thermal motion, we can use V << kT, expand the exponential function in p, and retain only the first two terms: p ∝ 1 – V/kT + · · · The weighted average of f is therefore ͗f ͘ = ͗f ͘0 − ͗f 2 ͘0 + · · · where ͗· · · ͘0 denotes an unweighted spherical average. The spherical average of f is zero, so the first term vanishes. However, the average value of f 2 is nonzero because f 2 is positive at all orientations, so we can write ͗V͘ = − The average value ͗f 2 ͘0 turns out to be 2–3 when the calculation is carried through in detail. The final result is that quoted in eqn 18.23. The important features of eqn 18.23 are its negative sign (the average interaction is attractive), the dependence of the average interaction energy on the inverse sixth power of the separation (which identifies it as a van der Waals interaction), and its inverse dependence on the temperature. The last feature reflects the way that the greater thermal motion overcomes the mutual orientating effects of the dipoles at higher temperatures. The inverse sixth power arises from the inverse third power of the interaction potential energy that is weighted by the energy in the Boltzmann term, which is also proportional to the inverse third power of the separation. At 25°C the average interaction energy for pairs of molecules with µ = 1 D is about −0.07 kJ mol−1 when the separation is 0.5 nm. This energy should be compared with µ1 2 µ2 2 ͗f 2 ͘0 (4πε0)2 kTr6 µ1µ2 4πε0kTr3 µ1µ2 f 4πε0r3 µ1µ2͗f ͘ 4πε0r3 2µ2 1µ2 2 3(4πε0)2 kT C r6 18.4 INTERACTIONS BETWEEN DIPOLES 633 the average molar kinetic energy of 3 –2RT = 3.7 kJ mol−1 at the same temperature. The interaction energy is also much smaller than the energies involved in the making and breaking of chemical bonds. (d) Dipole–induced-dipole interactions A polar molecule with dipole moment µ1 can induce a dipole µ2* in a neighbouring polarizable molecule (Fig. 18.6). The induced dipole interacts with the permanent dipole of the first molecule, and the two are attracted together. The average interaction energy when the separation of the molecules is r is (for a derivation, see Further reading) V = − C = (18.24) where α2′ is the polarizability volume of molecule 2 and µ1 is the permanent dipole moment of molecule 1. Note that the C in this expression is different from the C in eqn 18.23 and other expressions below: we are using the same symbol in C/r6 to emphasize the similarity of form of each expression. The dipole–induced-dipole interaction energy is independent of the temperature because thermal motion has no effect on the averaging process. Moreover, like the dipole–dipole interaction, the potential energy depends on 1/r6 : this distance dependence stems from the 1/r3 dependence of the field (and hence the magnitude of the induced dipole) and the 1/r3 dependence of the potential energy of interaction between the permanent and induced dipoles. For a molecule with µ = 1 D (such as HCl) near a molecule of polarizability volume α′ = 10 × 10−30 m3 (such as benzene, Table 18.1), the average interaction energy is about −0.8 kJ mol−1 when the separation is 0.3 nm. (e) Induced-dipole–induced-dipole interactions Nonpolar molecules (including closed-shell atoms, such as Ar) attract one another even though neither has a permanent dipole moment. The abundant evidence for the existence of interactions between them is the formation of condensed phases of nonpolar substances, such as the condensation of hydrogen or argon to a liquid at low temperatures and the fact that benzene is a liquid at normal temperatures. The interaction between nonpolar molecules arises from the transient dipoles that all molecules possess as a result of fluctuations in the instantaneous positions of electrons. To appreciate the origin of the interaction, suppose that the electrons in one molecule flicker into an arrangement that gives the molecule an instantaneous dipole moment µ1*. This dipole generates an electric field that polarizes the other molecule, and induces in that molecule an instantaneous dipole moment µ2*. The two dipoles attract each other and the potential energy of the pair is lowered. Although the first molecule will go on to change the size and direction of its instantaneous dipole, the electron distribution of the second molecule will follow; that is, the two dipoles are correlated in direction (Fig. 18.7). Because of this correlation, the attraction between the two instantaneous dipoles does not average to zero, and gives rise to an induceddipole–induced-dipole interaction. This interaction is called either the dispersion interaction or the London interaction (for Fritz London, who first described it). Polar molecules also interact by a dispersion interaction: such molecules also possess instantaneous dipoles, the only difference being that the time average of each fluctuating dipole does not vanish, but corresponds to the permanent dipole. Such molecules therefore interact both through their permanent dipoles and through the correlated, instantaneous fluctuations in these dipoles. The strength of the dispersion interaction depends on the polarizability of the first molecule because the instantaneous dipole moment µ1* depends on the looseness of µ2 1α′2 4πε0 C r6 (a) (b) Fig. 18.7 (a) In the dispersion interaction, an instantaneous dipole on one molecule induces a dipole on another molecule, and the two dipoles then interact to lower the energy. (b) The two instantaneous dipoles are correlated and, although they occur in different orientations at different instants, the interaction does not average to zero. Fig. 18.6 (a) A polar molecule (purple arrow) can induce a dipole (white arrow) in a nonpolar molecule, and (b) the latter’s orientation follows the former’s, so the interaction does not average to zero. (a) (b) 634 18 MOLECULAR INTERACTIONS Energy A H B Fig. 18.8 The molecular orbital interpretation of the formation of an AH···B hydrogen bond. From the three A, H, and B orbitals, three molecular orbitals can be formed (their relative contributions are represented by the sizes of the spheres. Only the two lower energy orbitals are occupied, and there may therefore be a net lowering of energy compared with the separate AH and B species. the control that the nuclear charge exercises over the outer electrons. The strength of the interaction also depends on the polarizability of the second molecule, for that polarizability determines how readily a dipole can be induced by another molecule. The actual calculation of the dispersion interaction is quite involved, but a reasonable approximation to the interaction energy is given by the London formula: V = − C = 3 –2α′1α′2 (18.25) where I1 and I2 are the ionization energies of the two molecules (Table 10.4). This interaction energy is also proportional to the inverse sixth power of the separation of the molecules, which identifies it as a third contribution to the van der Waals interaction. The dispersion interaction generally dominates all the interactions between molecules other than hydrogen bonds. Illustration 18.1 Calculating the strength of the dispersion interaction For two CH4 molecules, we can substitute α′ = 2.6 × 10−30 m3 and I ≈ 700 kJ mol−1 to obtain V = −2 kJ mol−1 for r = 0.3 nm. A very rough check on this figure is the enthalpy of vaporization of methane, which is 8.2 kJ mol−1 . However, this comparison is insecure, partly because the enthalpy of vaporization is a many-body quantity and partly because the long-distance assumption breaks down. (f) Hydrogen bonding The interactions described so far are universal in the sense that they are possessed by all molecules independent of their specific identity. However, there is a type of interaction possessed by molecules that have a particular constitution. A hydrogen bond is an attractive interaction between two species that arises from a link of the form A-H · · · B, where A and B are highly electronegative elements and B possesses a lone pair of electrons. Hydrogen bonding is conventionally regarded as being limited to N, O, and F but, if B is an anionic species (such as Cl− ), it may also participate in hydrogen bonding. There is no strict cutoff for an ability to participate in hydrogen bonding, but N, O, and F participate most effectively. The formation of a hydrogen bond can be regarded either as the approach between a partial positive charge of H and a partial negative charge of B or as a particular example of delocalized molecular orbital formation in which A, H, and B each supply one atomic orbital from which three molecular orbitals are constructed (Fig. 18.8). Thus, if the A-H bond is regarded as formed from the overlap of an orbital on A, ψA, and a hydrogen 1s orbital, ψH, and the lone pair on B occupies an orbital on B, ψB, then, when the two molecules are close together, we can build three molecular orbitals from the three basis orbitals: ψ = c1ψA + c2ψH + c3ψB One of the molecular orbitals is bonding, one almost nonbonding, and the third antibonding. These three orbitals need to accommodate four electrons (two from the original A-H bond and two from the lone pair of B), so two enter the bonding orbital and two enter the nonbonding orbital. Because the antibonding orbital remains empty, the net effect—depending on the precise location of the almost nonbonding orbital—may be a lowering of energy. In practice, the strength of the bond is found to be about 20 kJ mol−1 . Because the bonding depends on orbital overlap, it is virtually a contact-like interaction that is I1I2 I1 + I2 C r6 18.4 INTERACTIONS BETWEEN DIPOLES 635 turned on when AH touches B and is zero as soon as the contact is broken. If hydrogen bonding is present, it dominates the other intermolecular interactions. The properties of liquid and solid water, for example, are dominated by the hydrogen bonding between H2O molecules. The structure of DNA and hence the transmission of genetic information is crucially dependent on the strength of hydrogen bonds between base pairs. The structural evidence for hydrogen bonding comes from noting that the internuclear distance between formally non-bonded atoms is less than their van der Waals contact distance, which suggests that a dominating attractive interaction is present. For example, the O-O distance in O-H···O is expected to be 280 pm on the basis of van der Waals radii, but is found to be 270 pm in typical compounds. Moreover, the H···O distance is expected to be 260 pm but is found to be only 170 pm. Hydrogen bonds may be either symmetric or unsymmetric. In a symmetric hydrogen bond, the H atoms lies midway between the two other atoms. This arrangement is rare, but occurs in F-H···F− , where both bond lengths are 120 pm. More common is the unsymmetrical arrangement, where the A-H bond is shorter than the H···B bond. Simple electrostatic arguments, treating A-H···B as an array of point charges (partial negative charges on A and B, partial positive on H) suggest that the lowest energy is achieved when the bond is linear, because then the two partial negative charges are furthest apart. The experimental evidence from structural studies support a linear or near-linear arrangement. (g) The hydrophobic interaction Nonpolar molecules do dissolve slightly in polar solvents, but strong interactions between solute and solvent are not possible and as a result it is found that each individual solute molecule is surrounded by a solvent cage (Fig. 18.9). To understand the consequences of this effect, consider the thermodynamics of transfer of a nonpolar hydrocarbon solute from a nonpolar solvent to water, a polar solvent. Experiments indicate that the process is endergonic (∆transferG > 0), as expected on the basis of the increase in polarity of the solvent, but exothermic (∆transferH < 0). Therefore, it is a large decrease in the entropy of the system (∆transferS < 0) that accounts for the positive Gibbs energy of transfer. For example, the process CH4(in CCl4) → CH4(aq) has ∆transferG = +12 kJ mol−1 , ∆transferH = −10 kJ mol−1 , and ∆transferS = −75 J K−1 mol−1 at 298 K. Substances characterized by a positive Gibbs energy of transfer from a nonpolar to a polar solvent are called hydrophobic. It is possible to quantify the hydrophobicity of a small molecular group R by defining the hydrophobicity constant, π, as π = log [18.26] where S is the ratio of the molar solubility of the compound R-A in octanol, a nonpolar solvent, to that in water, and S0 is the ratio of the molar solubility of the compound H-A in octanol to that in water. Therefore, positive values of π indicate hydrophobicity and negative values of π indicate hydrophilicity, the thermodynamic preference for water as a solvent. It is observed experimentally that the π values of most groups do not depend on the nature of A. However, measurements do suggest group additivity of π values. For example, π for R = CH3, CH2CH3, (CH2)2CH3, (CH2)3CH3, and (CH2)4CH3 is, respectively, 0.5, 1.0, 1.5, 2.0, and 2.5 and we conclude that acyclic saturated hydrocarbons become more hydrophobic as the carbon chain length increases. This trend can be rationalized by ∆transferH becoming more positive and ∆transferS more negative as the number of carbon atoms in the chain increases. S S0 Fig. 18.9 When a hydrocarbon molecule is surrounded by water, the H2O molecules form a clathrate cage. As a result of this acquisition of structure, the entropy of the water decreases, so the dispersal of the hydrocarbon into the water is entropyopposed; its coalescence is entropy- favoured. 636 18 MOLECULAR INTERACTIONS At the molecular level, formation of a solvent cage around a hydrophobic molecule involves the formation of new hydrogen bonds among solvent molecules. This is an exothermic process and accounts for the negative values of ∆transferH. On the other hand, the increase in order associated with formation of a very large number of small solvent cages decreases the entropy of the system and accounts for the negative values of ∆transferS. However, when many solute molecules cluster together, fewer (albeit larger) cages are required and more solvent molecules are free to move. The net effect of formation of large clusters of hydrophobic molecules is then a decrease in the organization of the solvent and therefore a net increase in entropy of the system. This increase in entropy of the solvent is large enough to render spontaneous the association of hydrophobic molecules in a polar solvent. The increase in entropy that results from fewer structural demands on the solvent placed by the clustering of nonpolar molecules is the origin of the hydrophobic interaction, which tends to stabilize groupings of hydrophobic groups in micelles and biopolymers (Chapter 19). The hydrophobic interaction is an example of an ordering process that is stabilized by a tendency toward greater disorder of the solvent. (h) The total attractive interaction We shall consider molecules that are unable to participate in hydrogen bond formation. The total attractive interaction energy between rotating molecules is then the sum of the three van der Waals contributions discussed above. (Only the dispersion interaction contributes if both molecules are nonpolar.) In a fluid phase, all three contributions to the potential energy vary as the inverse sixth power of the separation of the molecules, so we may write V = − (18.27) where C6 is a coefficient that depends on the identity of the molecules. Although attractive interactions between molecules are often expressed as in eqn 18.27, we must remember that this equation has only limited validity. First, we have taken into account only dipolar interactions of various kinds, for they have the longest range and are dominant if the average separation of the molecules is large. However, in a complete treatment we should also consider quadrupolar and higher-order multipole interactions, particularly if the molecules do not have permanent electric dipole moments. Secondly, the expressions have been derived by assuming that the molecules can rotate reasonably freely. That is not the case in most solids, and in rigid media the dipole–dipole interaction is proportional to 1/r3 because the Boltzmann averaging procedure is irrelevant when the molecules are trapped into a fixed orientation. A different kind of limitation is that eqn 18.27 relates to the interactions of pairs of molecules. There is no reason to suppose that the energy of interaction of three (or more) molecules is the sum of the pairwise interaction energies alone. The total dispersion energy of three closed-shell atoms, for instance, is given approximately by the Axilrod–Teller formula: V = − − − + (18.28a) where C′ = a(3 cos θA cos θB cos θC + 1) (18.28b) The parameter a is approximately equal to 3 –4α′C6; the angles θ are the internal angles of the triangle formed by the three atoms (14). The term in C′ (which represents the non-additivity of the pairwise interactions) is negative for a linear arrangement of C′ (rABrBCrCA)3 C6 r6 CA C6 r6 BC C6 r6 AB C6 r6 B rAB rBC rCA 14 q Aq Cq 18.5 REPULSIVE AND TOTAL INTERACTIONS 637 atoms (so that arrangement is stabilized) and positive for an equilateral triangular cluster. It is found that the three-body term contributes about 10 per cent of the total interaction energy in liquid argon. 18.5 Repulsive and total interactions When molecules are squeezed together, the nuclear and electronic repulsions and the rising electronic kinetic energy begin to dominate the attractive forces. The repulsions increase steeply with decreasing separation in a way that can be deduced only by very extensive, complicated molecular structure calculations of the kind described in Chapter 11 (Fig. 18.10). In many cases, however, progress can be made by using a greatly simplified representation of the potential energy, where the details are ignored and the general features expressed by a few adjustable parameters. One such approximation is the hardsphere potential, in which it is assumed that the potential energy rises abruptly to infinity as soon as the particles come within a separation d: V = ∞ for r ≤ d V = 0 for r > d (18.29) This very simple potential is surprisingly useful for assessing a number of properties. Another widely used approximation is the Mie potential: V = − (18.30) with n > m. The first term represents repulsions and the second term attractions. The Lennard-Jones potential is a special case of the Mie potential with n = 12 and m = 6 (Fig. 18.11); it is often written in the form V = 4ε 12 − 6 (18.31) The two parameters are ε, the depth of the well (not to be confused with the symbol of the permittivity of a medium used in Section 18.3), and r0, the separation at which V = 0 (Table 18.4). The well minimum occurs at re = 21/6 r0. Although the LennardJones potential has been used in many calculations, there is plenty of evidence to show that 1/r12 is a very poor representation of the repulsive potential, and that an exponential form, e−r/r0 , is greatly superior. An exponential function is more faithful to the exponential decay of atomic wavefunctions at large distances, and hence to the overlap that is responsible for repulsion. The potential with an exponential repulsive term and a 1/r6 attractive term is known as an exp-6potential. These potentials can be used to calculate the virial coefficients of gases, as explained in Section 17.5, and through them various properties of real gases, such as the Joule–Thompson coefficient. The potentials are also used to model the structures of condensed fluids. With the advent of atomic force microscopy (AFM), in which the force between a molecular sized probe and a surface is monitored (see Impact I9.1), it has become possible to measure directly the forces acting between molecules. The force, F, is the negative slope of potential, so for a Lennard-Jones potential between individual molecules we write F = − = 2 13 − 7 (18.32) The net attractive force is greatest (from dF/dr = 0) at r = (26 ––7 )1/6 r0, or 1.244r0, and at that distance is equal to −144( 7 ––26)7/6 ε/13r0, or −2.397ε/r0. For typical parameters, the magnitude of this force is about 10 pN. 5 6 7 D F r0 r A C D F r0 r A C 1 2 3 24ε r0 dV dr 5 6 7 D F r0 r A C D F r0 r A C 1 2 3 Cm rm Cn rn Potentialenergy 0 -1/r 6 2 1/6 r0 1/r12 r -e Fig. 18.11 The Lennard-Jones potential, and the relation of the parameters to the features of the curve. The green and purple lines are the two contributions. Synoptic table 18.4* Lennard-Jones (12,6) parameters (e/k)/K r0/pm Ar 111.84 362.3 CCl4 376.86 624.1 N2 91.85 391.9 Xe 213.96 426.0 * More values are given in the Data section. Repulsion Attraction Total Potentialenergy Distance 0 Fig. 18.10 The general form of an intermolecular potential energy curve. At long range the interaction is attractive, but at close range the repulsions dominate. 638 18 MOLECULAR INTERACTIONS IMPACT ON MEDICINE I18.1 Molecular recognition and drug design A drug is a small molecule or protein that binds to a specific receptor site of a target molecule, such as a larger protein or nucleic acid, and inhibits the progress of disease. To devise efficient therapies, we need to know how to characterize and optimize molecular interactions between drug and target. Molecular interactions are responsible for the assembly of many biological structures. Hydrogen bonding and hydrophobic interactions are primarily responsible for the three-dimensional structures of biopolymers, such as proteins, nucleic acids, and cell membranes. The binding of a ligand, or guest, to a biopolymer, or host, is also governed by molecular interactions. Examples of biological host–guest complexes include enzyme–substrate complexes, antigen–antibody complexes, and drug–receptor complexes. In all these cases, a site on the guest contains functional groups that can interact with complementary functional groups of the host. For example, a hydrogen bond donor group of the guest must be positioned near a hydrogen bond acceptor group of the host for tight binding to occur. It is generally true that many specific intermolecular contacts must be made in a biological host–guest complex and, as a result, a guest binds only hosts that are chemically similar. The strict rules governing molecular recognition of a guest by a host control every biological process, from metabolism to immunological response, and provide important clues for the design of effective drugs for the treatment of disease. Interactions between nonpolar groups can be important in the binding of a guest to a host. For example, many enzyme active sites have hydrophobic pockets that bind nonpolar groups of a substrate. In addition to dispersion, repulsive, and hydrophobic interactions, π stacking interactions are also possible, in which the planar π systems of aromatic macrocycles lie one on top of the other, in a nearly parallel orientation. Such interactions are responsible for the stacking of hydrogen-bonded base pairs in DNA (Fig. 18.12). Some drugs with planar π systems, shown as a green rectangle in Fig. 18.12, are effective because they intercalate between base pairs through π stacking interactions, causing the helix to unwind slightly and altering the function of DNA. Coulombic interactions can be important in the interior of a biopolymer host, where the relative permittivity can be much lower than that of the aqueous exterior. For example, at physiological pH, amino acid side chains containing carboxylic acid or amine groups are negatively and positively charged, respectively, and can attract each other. Dipole–dipole interactions are also possible because many of the building blocks of biopolymers are polar, including the peptide link, -CONH- (see Example 18.1). However, hydrogen bonding interactions are by far the most prevalent in a biological host–guest complexes. Many effective drugs bind tightly and inhibit the action of enzymes that are associated with the progress of a disease. In many cases, a successful inhibitor will be able to form the same hydrogen bonds with the binding site that the normal substrate of the enzyme can form, except that the drug is chemically inert toward the enzyme. There are two main strategies for the discovery of a drug. In structure-based design, new drugs are developed on the basis of the known structure of the receptor site of a known target. However, in many cases a number of so-called lead compounds are known to have some biological activity but little information is available about the target. To design a molecule with improved pharmacological efficacy, quantitative structure–activity relationships (QSAR) are often established by correlating data on activity of lead compounds with molecular properties, also called molecular descriptors, which can be determined either experimentally or computationally. In broad terms, the first stage of the QSAR method consists of compiling molecular descriptors for a very large number of lead compounds. Descriptors such as molar T A C G T A G C T A C G G C Intercalation T A Fig. 18.12 Some drugs with planar π systems, shown as a green rectangle, intercalate between base pairs of DNA. I18.1 IMPACT ON MEDICINE: MOLECULAR RECOGNITION AND DRUG DESIGN 639 mass, molecular dimensions and volume, and relative solubility in water and nonpolar solvents are available from routine experimental procedures. Quantum mechanical descriptors determined by semi-empirical and ab initio calculations include bond orders and HOMO and LUMO energies. In the second stage of the process, biological activity is expressed as a function of the molecular descriptors. An example of a QSAR equation is: Activity = c0 + c1d1 + c2d1 2 + c3d2 + c4d2 2 + . . . (18.33) where di is the value of the descriptor and ci is a coefficient calculated by fitting the data by regression analysis. The quadratic terms account for the fact that biological activity can have a maximum or minimum value at a specific descriptor value. For example, a molecule might not cross a biological membrane and become available for binding to targets in the interior of the cell if it is too hydrophilic (water-loving), in which case it will not partition into the hydrophobic layer of the cell membrane (see Section 19.14 for details of membrane structure), or too hydrophobic (water-repelling), for then it may bind too tightly to the membrane. It follows that the activity will peak at some intermediate value of a parameter that measures the relative solubility of the drug in water and organic solvents. In the final stage of the QSAR process, the activity of a drug candidate can be estimated from its molecular descriptors and the QSAR equation either by interpolation or extrapolation of the data. The predictions are more reliable when a large number of lead compounds and molecular descriptors are used to generate the QSAR equation. The traditional QSAR technique has been refined into 3D QSAR, in which sophisticated computational methods are used to gain further insight into the threedimensional features of drug candidates that lead to tight binding to the receptor site of a target. The process begins by using a computer to superimpose three-dimensional structural models of lead compounds and looking for common features, such as similarities in shape, location of functional groups, and electrostatic potential plots, which can be obtained from molecular orbital calculations. The key assumption of the method is that common structural features are indicative of molecular properties that enhance binding of the drug to the receptor. The collection of superimposed molecules is then placed inside a three-dimensional grid of points. An atomic probe, typically an sp3 -hybridized carbon atom, visits each grid point and two energies of interaction are calculated: Esteric, the steric energy reflecting interactions between the probe and electrons in uncharged regions of the drug, and Eelec, the electrostatic energy arising from interactions between the probe and a region of the molecule carrying a partial charge. The measured equilibrium constant for binding of the drug to the target, Kbind, is then assumed to be related to the interaction energies at each point r by the 3D QSAR equation log Kbind = c0 + ∑ r {cS(r)Esteric(r) + cE(r)Eelec(r)} (18.34) where the c(r) are coefficients calculated by regression analysis, with the coefficients cS and cE reflecting the relative importance of steric and electrostatic interactions, respectively, at the grid point r. Visualization of the regression analysis is facilitated by colouring each grid point according to the magnitude of the coefficients. Figure 18.13 shows results of a 3D QSAR analysis of the binding of steroids, molecules with the carbon skeleton shown, to human corticosteroid-binding globulin (CBG). Indeed, we see that the technique lives up to the promise of opening a window into the chemical nature of the binding site even when its structure is not known. The QSAR and 3D QSAR methods, though powerful, have limited power: the predictions are only as good as the data used in the correlations are both reliable and Positive potential, steric flexibility Negative potential Positive potential, steric crowding Fig. 18.13 A 3D QSAR analysis of the binding of steroids, molecules with the carbon skeleton shown, to human corticosteroidbinding globulin (CBG). The ellipses indicate areas in the protein’s binding site with positive or negative electrostatic potentials and with little or much steric crowding. It follows from the calculations that addition of large substituents near the left-hand side of the molecule (as it is drawn on the page) leads to poor affinity of the drug to the binding site. Also, substituents that lead to the accumulation of negative electrostatic potential at either end of the drug are likely to show enhanced affinity for the binding site. (Adapted from P. Krogsgaard-Larsen, T. Liljefors, U. Madsen (ed.), Textbook of drug design and discovery, Taylor & Francis, London (2002).) 640 18 MOLECULAR INTERACTIONS abundant. However, the techniques have been used successfully to identify compounds that deserve further synthetic elaboration, such as addition or removal of functional groups, and testing. Gases and liquids The form of matter with the least order is a gas. In a perfect gas there are no intermolecular interactions and the distribution of molecules is completely random. In a real gas there are weak attractions and repulsions that have minimal effect on the relative locations of the molecules but that cause deviations from the perfect gas law for the dependence of pressure on the volume, temperature, and amount (Section 1.3). The attractions between molecules are responsible for the condensation of gases into liquids at low temperatures. At low enough temperatures the molecules of a gas have insufficient kinetic energy to escape from each other’s attraction and they stick together. Second, although molecules attract each other when they are a few diameters apart, as soon as they come into contact they repel each other. This repulsion is responsible for the fact that liquids and solids have a definite bulk and do not collapse to an infinitesimal point. The molecules are held together by molecular interactions, but their kinetic energies are comparable to their potential energies. As a result, we saw in Section 17.6 that, although the molecules of a liquid are not free to escape completely from the bulk, the whole structure is very mobile and we can speak only of the average relative locations of molecules. In the following sections we build on those concepts and add thermodynamic arguments to describe the surface of a liquid and the condensation of a gas into a liquid. 18.6 Molecular interactions in gases Molecular interactions in the gas phase can be studied in molecular beams, which consist of a collimated, narrow stream of molecules travelling though an evacuated vessel. The beam is directed towards other molecules, and the scattering that occurs on impact is related to the intermolecular interactions. The primary experimental information from a molecular beam experiment is the fraction of the molecules in the incident beam that are scattered into a particular direction. The fraction is normally expressed in terms of dI, the rate at which molecules are scattered into a cone that represents the area covered by the ‘eye’ of the detector (Fig. 18.14). This rate is reported as the differential scattering cross-section, σ, the constant of proportionality between the value of dI and the intensity, I, of the incident beam, the number density of target molecules, N , and the infinitesimal path length dx through the sample: dI = σINdx (18.35) The value of σ (which has the dimensions of area) depends on the impact parameter, b,theinitialperpendicularseparationofthepathsofthecollidingmolecules(Fig.18.15), and the details of the intermolecular potential. The role of the impact parameter is most easily seen by considering the impact of two hard spheres (Fig. 18.16). If b = 0, the lighter projectile is on a trajectory that leads to a head-on collision, so the only scattering intensity is detected when the detector is at θ = π. When the impact parameter is so great that the spheres do not make contact (b > RA + RB), there is no scattering and the scattering cross-section is zero at all angles except θ = 0. Glancing blows, with 0 < b ≤ RA + RB, lead to scattering intensity in cones around the forward direction. W dW b Fig. 18.14 The definition of the solid angle, dΩ, for scattering. Fig. 18.15 The definition of the impact parameter, b, as the perpendicular separation of the initial paths of the particles. 0 < < +b R RA B b R R> +A B b 0= (a) (b) (c) RA RB Fig. 18.16 Three typical cases for the collisions of two hard spheres: (a) b = 0, giving backward scattering; (b) b > RA + RB, giving forward scattering; (c) 0 < b < RA + RB, leading to scattering into one direction on a ring of possibilities. (The target molecule is taken to be so heavy that it remains virtually stationary.) 18.7 THE LIQUID–VAPOUR INTERFACE 641 The scattering pattern of real molecules, which are not hard spheres, depends on the details of the intermolecular potential, including the anisotropy that is present when the molecules are non-spherical. The scattering also depends on the relative speed of approach of the two particles: a very fast particle might pass through the interaction region without much deflection, whereas a slower one on the same path might be temporarily captured and undergo considerable deflection (Fig. 18.17). The variation of the scattering cross-section with the relative speed of approach should therefore give information about the strength and range of the intermolecular potential. A further point is that the outcome of collisions is determined by quantum, not classical, mechanics. The wave nature of the particles can be taken into account, at least to some extent, by drawing all classical trajectories that take the projectile particle from source to detector, and then considering the effects of interference between them. Two quantum mechanical effects are of great importance. A particle with a certain impact parameter might approach the attractive region of the potential in such a way that the particle is deflected towards the repulsive core (Fig. 18.18), which then repels it out through the attractive region to continue its flight in the forward direction. Some molecules, however, also travel in the forward direction because they have impact parameters so large that they are undeflected. The wavefunctions of the particles that take the two types of path interfere, and the intensity in the forward direction is modified. The effect is called quantum oscillation. The same phenomenon accounts for the optical ‘glory effect’, in which a bright halo can sometimes be seen surrounding an illuminated object. (The coloured rings around the shadow of an air- craftcastoncloudsbytheSun,andoftenseeninflight,isanexampleofanopticalglory.) The second quantum effect we need consider is the observation of a strongly enhanced scattering in a non-forward direction. This effect is called rainbow scattering because the same mechanism accounts for the appearance of an optical rainbow. The origin of the phenomenon is illustrated in Fig. 18.19. As the impact parameter decreases, there comes a stage at which the scattering angle passes through a maximum and the interference between the paths results in a strongly scattered beam. The rainbow angle, θr, is the angle for which dθ/db = 0 and the scattering is strong. Another phenomenon that can occur in certain beams is the capturing of one species by another. The vibrational temperature in supersonic beams is so low that van der Waals molecules may be formed, which are complexes of the form AB in which A and B are held together by van der Waals forces or hydrogen bonds. Large numbers of such molecules have been studied spectroscopically, including ArHCl, (HCl)2, ArCO2, and (H2O)2. More recently, van der Waals clusters of water molecules have been pursued as far as (H2O)6. The study of their spectroscopic properties gives detailed information about the intermolecular potentials involved. 18.7 The liquid–vapour interface So far, we have concentrated on the properties of gases. In Section 17.6, we described the structure of liquids. Now we turn our attention to the physical boundary between phases, such as the surface where solid is in contact with liquid or liquid is in contact with its vapour, has interesting properties. In this section we concentrate on the liquid–vapour interface, which is interesting because it is so mobile. Chapter 25 deals with solid surfaces and their important role in catalysis. (a) Surface tension Liquids tend to adopt shapes that minimize their surface area, for then the maximum number of molecules are in the bulk and hence surrounded by and interacting with neighbours. Droplets of liquids therefore tend to be spherical, because a sphere is the Slow molecule Fast molecule Fig. 18.17 The extent of scattering may depend on the relative speed of approach as well as the impact parameter. The darker central zone represents the repulsive core; the fuzzy outer zone represents the longrange attractive potential. Interfering paths Fig. 18.18 Two paths leading to the same destination will interfere quantum mechanically; in this case they give rise to quantum oscillations in the forward direction. Decreasing b Varying rq q Fig. 18.19 The interference of paths leading to rainbow scattering. The rainbow angle, θr, is the maximum scattering angle reached as b is decreased. Interference between the numerous paths at that angle modifies the scattering intensity markedly. 642 18 MOLECULAR INTERACTIONS Synoptic table 18.5* Surface tensions of liquids at 293 K g/(mN m−1 )† Benzene 28.88 Mercury 472 Methanol 22.6 Water 72.75 * More values are given in the Data section. † Note that 1 N m−1 = 1 J m−2 . Force 2 l l h Total area 2hl g Fig. 18.20 The model used for calculating the work of forming a liquid film when a wire of length l is raised and pulls the surface with it through a height h. shape with the smallest surface-to-volume ratio. However, there may be other forces present that compete against the tendency to form this ideal shape, and in particular gravity may flatten spheres into puddles or oceans. Surface effects may be expressed in the language of Helmholtz and Gibbs energies (Chapter 3). The link between these quantities and the surface area is the work needed to change the area by a given amount, and the fact that dA and dG are equal (under different conditions) to the work done in changing the energy of a system. The work needed to change the surface area, σ, of a sample by an infinitesimal amount dσ is proportional to dσ, and we write dw = γdσ [18.36] The constant of proportionality, γ, is called the surface tension; its dimensions are energy/area and its units are typically joules per metre squared (J m−2 ). However, as in Table 18.5, values of γ are usually reported in newtons per metre (N m−1 , because 1 J = 1 N m). The work of surface formation at constant volume and temperature can be identified with the change in the Helmholtz energy, and we can write dA = γdσ (18.37) Because the Helmholtz energy decreases (dA < 0) if the surface area decreases (dσ < 0), surfaces have a natural tendency to contract. This is a more formal way of expressing what we have already described. Example 18.4 Using the surface tension Calculate the work needed to raise a wire of length l and to stretch the surface of a liquid through a height h in the arrangement shown in Fig. 18.20. Disregard gravitational potential energy. Method According to eqn 18.36, the work required to create a surface area given that the surface tension does not vary as the surface is formed is w = γσ. Therefore, all we need do is to calculate the surface area of the two-sided rectangle formed as the frame is withdrawn from the liquid. Answer When the wire of length l is raised through a height h it increases the area of the liquid by twice the area of the rectangle (because there is a surface on each side). The total increase is therefore 2lh and the work done is 2γlh. The work can be expressed as a force × distance by writing it as 2γl × h, and identifying γ l as the opposing force on the wire of length l. This is why γ is called a tension and why its units are often chosen to be newtons per metre (N m−1 , so γl is a force in newtons). Self-test 18.5 Calculate the work of creating a spherical cavity of radius r in a liquid of surface tension γ. [4πr2 γ] (b) Curved surfaces The minimization of the surface area of a liquid may result in the formation of a curved surface. A bubble is a region in which vapour (and possibly air too) is trapped by a thin film; a cavity is a vapour-filled hole in a liquid. What are widely called ‘bubbles’ in liquids are therefore strictly cavities. True bubbles have two surfaces (one on each side of the film); cavities have only one. The treatments of both are similar, but a factor of 2 is required for bubbles to take into account the doubled surface area. A droplet is a small volume of liquid at equilibrium surrounded by its vapour (and possibly also air). 18.7 THE LIQUID–VAPOUR INTERFACE 643 The pressure on the concave side of an interface, pin, is always greater than the pressure on the convex side, pout. This relation is expressed by the Laplace equation, which is derived in the following Justification: pin = pout + (18.38) Justification 18.6 The Laplace equation The cavities in a liquid are at equilibrium when the tendency for their surface area to decrease is balanced by the rise of internal pressure which would then result. When the pressure inside a cavity is pin and its radius is r, the outward force is pressure × area = 4πr2 pin The force inwards arises from the external pressure and the surface tension. The former has magnitude 4πr2 pout. The latter is calculated as follows. The change in surface area when the radius of a sphere changes from r to r + dr is dσ = 4π(r + dr)2 − 4πr2 = 8πrdr (The second-order infinitesimal, (dr)2 , is ignored.) The work done when the surface is stretched by this amount is therefore dw = 8πγrdr As force × distance is work, the force opposing stretching through a distance dr when the radius is r is F = 8πγr The total inward force is therefore 4πr2 pout + 8πγr. At equilibrium, the outward and inward forces are balanced, so we can write 4πr2 pin = 4πr2 pout + 8πγr which rearranges into eqn 18.38. The Laplace equation shows that the difference in pressure decreases to zero as the radius of curvature becomes infinite (when the surface is flat, Fig. 18.21). Small cavities have small radii of curvature, so the pressure difference across their surface is quite large. For instance, a ‘bubble’ (actually, a cavity) of radius 0.10 mm in champagne implies a pressure difference of 1.5 kPa, which is enough to sustain a column of water of height 15 cm. (c) Capillary action The tendency of liquids to rise up capillary tubes (tubes of narrow bore), which is called capillary action, is a consequence of surface tension. Consider what happens when a glass capillary tube is first immersed in water or any liquid that has a tendency to adhere to the walls. The energy is lowest when a thin film covers as much of the glass as possible. As this film creeps up the inside wall it has the effect of curving the surface of the liquid inside the tube. This curvature implies that the pressure just beneath the curving meniscus is less than the atmospheric pressure by approximately 2γ/r, where r is the radius of the tube and we assume a hemispherical surface. The pressure immediately under the flat surface outside the tube is p, the atmospheric pressure; but inside the tube under the curved surface it is only p − 2γ/r. The excess external pressure presses the liquid up the tube until hydrostatic equilibrium (equal pressures at equal depths) has been reached (Fig. 18.22). 2γ r Pressureinside,pin Radius, r r pin pout pout Increasing surface tension, g Fig. 18.21 The dependence of the pressure inside a curved surface on the radius of the surface, for two different values of the surface tension. P P P PPP Prgh-2/+ h rg Fig. 18.22 When a capillary tube is first stood in a liquid, the latter climbs up the walls, so curving the surface. The pressure just under the meniscus is less than that arising from the atmosphere by 2γ/r. The pressure is equal at equal heights throughout the liquid provided the hydrostatic pressure (which is equal to ρgh) cancels the pressure difference arising from the curvature. 644 18 MOLECULAR INTERACTIONS -20 0 20 40 60 80 100 58 62 66 70 74 78 Temperature, /°C Surfacetension,/(mNm)-1 q g Fig. 18.23 The variation of the surface tension of water with temperature. lg sl sg c g g g q Fig. 18.24 The balance of forces that results in a contact angle, θc. To calculate the height to which the liquid rises, we note that the pressure exerted by a column of liquid of mass density ρ and height h is p = ρgh (18.39) This hydrostatic pressure matches the pressure difference 2γ/r at equilibrium. Therefore, the height of the column at equilibrium is obtained by equating 2γ/r and ρgh, which gives h = (18.40) This simple expression provides a reasonably accurate way of measuring the surface tension of liquids. Surface tension decreases with increasing temperature (Fig. 18.23). Illustration 18.2 Calculating the surface tension of a liquid from its capillary rise If water at 25°C rises through 7.36 cm in a capillary of radius 0.20 mm, its surface tension at that temperature is γ = 1 –2ρghr = 1 –2 × (997.1 kg m−3 ) × (9.81 m s−2 ) × (7.36 × 10−2 m) × (2.0 × 10−4 m) = 72 mN m−1 where we have used 1 kg m s−2 = 1 N. When the adhesive forces between the liquid and the material of the capillary wall are weaker than the cohesive forces within the liquid (as for mercury in glass), the liquid in the tube retracts from the walls. This retraction curves the surface with the concave, high pressure side downwards. To equalize the pressure at the same depth throughout the liquid the surface must fall to compensate for the heightened pressure arising from its curvature. This compensation results in a capillary depression. In many cases there is a nonzero angle between the edge of the meniscus and the wall. If this contact angle is θc, then eqn 18.40 should be modified by multiplying the right-hand side by cos θc. The origin of the contact angle can be traced to the balance of forces at the line of contact between the liquid and the solid (Fig. 18.24). If the solid–gas, solid–liquid, and liquid–gas surface tensions (essentially the energy needed to create unit area of each of the interfaces) are denoted γsg, γsl, and γlg, respectively, then the vertical forces are in balance if γsg = γsl + γlg cosθc (18.41) This expression solves to cosθc = (18.42) If we note that the superficial work of adhesion of the liquid to the solid (the work of adhesion divided by the area of contact) is wad = γsg + γlg − γsl (18.43) eqn 18.42 can be written cosθc = − l (18.44) We now see that the liquid ‘wets’ (spreads over) the surface, corresponding to 0 < θc < 90°, when 1 < wad/γlg < 2 (Fig. 18.25). The liquid does not wet the surface, wad γlg γsg − γsl γlg 2γ ρgr 18.8 CONDENSATION 645 correspondingto90°<θc <180°,when0 Nl, the values are so small that the errors in pretending that r can range up to infinity are negligible. An alternative interpretation of eqn 19.27 is to regard each coil in a sample as ceaselessly writhing from one conformation to another; then f(r)dr is the probability that at any instant the chain will be found with the separation of its ends between r and r + dr. Justification 19.3 The one-dimensional freely jointed chain Consider a one-dimensional freely jointed polymer. We can specify the conformation of a molecule by stating the number of bonds pointing to the right (NR) and the number pointing to the left (NL). The distance between the ends of the chain is (NR − NL)l, where l is the length of an individual bond. We write n = NR − NL and the total number of bonds as N = NR + NL. The number of ways W of forming a chain with a given end-to-end distance nl is the number of ways of having NR right-pointing and NL left-pointing bonds. There are N(N – 1)(N – 2) . . . 1 = N! ways of selecting whether a step should be to the right or the left. If NL steps are to the left, NR = N – NL will be to the right. However, we end up at the same point for all NL! and NR! choices of which step is to the left and which to the right. Therefore W = = (19.28) The probability that the separation is nl is P = = = When the chain is compact in the sense that n << N, it is more convenient to evaluate ln P: the factorials are then large and we can use Stirling’s approximation (Section 16.1a) in the form ln x! ≈ ln(2π)1/2 + (x + 1–2)ln x − x The result, after quite a lot of algebra, is ln P = ln 1/2 − 1–2(N + n + 1)ln(1 + ν) − 1–2(N − n + 1)ln(1 − ν) (19.29) D F 2 πN A C N! {1–2(N + n)}!{1–2(N − n)}!2N N!/NR!(N − NR)! 2N number of polymers with NR bonds to the right total number of arrangements of bonds N! {1–2(N + n)}!{1–2(N − n)}! N! NL!NR! D F 3 2Nl2 A C D F a π1/2 A C D F 2 πN A C 0 2 4-4 -2 0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1 PN/(2/)1/2 n N/ 1/2 p Fig. 19.17 The probability distribution for the separation of the ends of a onedimensional random coil. The separation of the ends is nl, where l is the bond length. 670 19 MATERIALS 1: MACROMOLECULES AND AGGREGATES 0 1000 2000 3000 4000 Number of monomers, N 0 20 40 60 Rlrms/ Fig. 19.18 The variation of the root mean square separation of the ends of a threedimensional random coil, Rrms, with the number of monomers. where ν = n/N. For a compact coil (ν << 1) we use the approximation ln(1 ± ν) ≈ ±ν − 1–2ν2 and so obtain lnP ≈ ln 1/2 − 1–2Nν2 which rearranges into eqn 19.26. Self-test 19.6 Provide the algebraic steps that lead from eqn 19.28 to eqn 19.29. There are several measures of the geometrical size of a random coil. The contour length, Rc, is the length of the macromolecule measured along its backbone from atom to atom. For a polymer of N monomer units each of length l, the contour length is Rc = Nl (19.30) The root mean square separation, Rrms, is a measure of the average separation of the ends of a random coil: it is the square root of the mean value of R2 . We show in the following Justification that: Rrms = N1/2 l (19.31) We see that, as the number of monomer units increases, the root mean square separation of its end increases as N1/2 (Fig. 19.18), and consequently its volume increases as N3/2 . The result must be multiplied by a factor when the chain is not freely jointed (see below). Justification 19.4 The root mean square separation of the ends of a freely jointed chain In Appendix 2 we see that the mean value ͗X͘ of a variable X with possible values x is given by ͗X͘ = Ύ +∞ −∞ xf(x)dx where the function f(x) is the probability density, a measure of the distribution of the probability values over x, and dx is an infinitesimally small interval of x values. The mean value of a function g(X) can be calculated with a similar formula: ͗g(X)͘ = Ύ +∞ −∞ g(x)f(x)dx To apply these concepts to the calculation of the root mean square separation of the ends of a random coil, we identify f(r)dr as the probability that the ends of the chain lie in the range R = r to R = r + dr. It follows that the general expression for the mean nth power of the end-to-end separation (a positive quantity that can vary from 0 to +∞) is ͗Rn ͘ = Ύ ∞ 0 rn f(r)dr To calculate Rrms, we first determine ͗R2 ͘ by using n = 2 and f(r) from eqn 19.27: ͗R2 ͘ = 4π 3 Ύ ∞ 0 r4 e−a2 r2 dr = 4π 3 × = 3 2a2 3π1/2 8a5 D E F a π1/2 A B C D E F a π1/2 A B C D F 2 πN A C 19.8 RANDOM COILS 671 where we have used the standard integral Ύ ∞ 0 x4 e−a2 x2 dx = When we use the expression for a in eqn 19.27 we obtain: ͗R2 ͘ = × = Nl2 The root mean square separation follows from Rrms = ͗R2 ͘1/2 = N1/2 l Self-test 19.7 Calculate the mean separation of the ends of a freely jointed chain of N bonds of length l. Hint. You will need the standard integral Ύ ∞ 0 x3 e−a2x2 dx = 1 –2a4 . [͗R͘ = 1/2 l] Another convenient measure of size is the radius of gyration, Rg, which we encountered in Section 19.3a. It is calculated formally from the expression: Rg = 1 –2 ∑ ij R2 ij 1/2 (19.32) where Rij is the separation of atoms i and j. The radius of gyration of the coil also increases as N1/2 : Rg = 1/2 l (19.33) The radius of gyration may also be calculated for other geometries. For example, a solid uniform sphere of radius R has Rg = (3 –5)1/2 R, and a long thin uniform rod of length l has Rg = l/(12)1/2 for rotation about an axis perpendicular to the long axis. The random coil model ignores the role of the solvent: a poor solvent will tend to cause the coil to tighten so that solute–solvent contacts are minimized; a good solvent does the opposite. Therefore, calculations based on this model are better regarded as lower bounds to the dimensions for a polymer in a good solvent and as an upper bound for a polymer in a poor solvent. The model is most reliable for a polymer in a bulk solid sample, where the coil is likely to have its natural dimensions. (b) Conformational entropy The random coil is the least structured conformation of a polymer chain and corresponds to the state of greatest entropy. Any stretching of the coil introduces order and reduces the entropy. Conversely, the formation of a random coil from a more extended form is a spontaneous process (provided enthalpy contributions do not interfere). As shown in the Justification below, we can use the same model to deduce that the change in conformational entropy, the statistical entropy arising from the arrangement of bonds, when a coil containing N bonds of length l is stretched or compressed by nl is ∆S = −1 –2kN ln{(1 + ν)1+ν (1 − ν)1−ν } ν = n/N (19.34) D F N 6 A C D F A C 1 N D F 8N 3π A C D E F 2Nl2 3 A B C 3 2 3 2a2 672 19 MATERIALS 1: MACROMOLECULES AND AGGREGATES 0 -0.1 -0.2 -0.3 -0.4 DSkN/ -0.8 -0.4 0 0.4 0.8 /= n Nn Fig. 19.19 The change in molar entropy of a perfect elastomer as its extension changes; ν = 1 corresponds to complete extension; ν = 0, the conformation of highest entropy, corresponds to the random coil. RrmsRg á ñR Fig. 19.20 A random coil in three dimensions. This one contains about 200 units. The root mean square distance between the ends (Rrms), the mean radius, and the radius of gyration (Rg) are indicated. This function is plotted in Fig. 19.19, and we see that minimum extension corresponds to maximum entropy. Justification 19.5 The conformational entropy of a freely jointed chain The conformational entropy of the chain is S = k ln W, where W is given by eqn 19.28. Therefore, S/k = ln N! − ln{1–2(N + n)}! − ln{1–2(N − n)}! Because the factorials are large (except for large extensions), we can use Stirling’s approximation to obtain S/k = −ln(2π)1/2 + (N + 1)ln 2 + (N + 1–2)ln N − 1–2 ln{(N + n)N+n+1 (N − n)N−n+1 } The most probable conformation of the chain is the one with the ends close together (n = 0), as may be confirmed by differentiation. Therefore, the maximum entropy is S/k = −ln(2π)1/2 + (N + 1)ln 2 + 1–2 ln N The change in entropy when the chain is stretched or compressed by nl is therefore the difference of these two quantities, and the resulting expression is eqn 19.34. (c) Constrained chains The freely jointed chain model is improved by removing the freedom of bond angles to take any value. For long chains, we can simply take groups of neighbouring bonds and consider the direction of their resultant. Although each successive individual bond is constrained to a single cone of angle θ relative to its neighbour, the resultant of several bonds lies in a random direction. By concentrating on such groups rather than individuals, it turns out that for long chains the expressions for the root mean square separation and the radius of gyration given above should be multiplied by F = 1/2 (19.35) For tetrahedral bonds, for which cos θ = −1 –3 (that is, θ = 109.5°), F = 21/2 . Therefore: Rrms = (2N)1/2 l Rg = 1/2 l (19.36) Illustration 19.2 The dimensions of a polymer chain Consider a polyethylene chain with M = 56 kg mol−1 , corresponding to N = 4000. Because l = 154 pm for a C-C bond, we find Rrms = 14 nm and Rg = 5.6 nm (Fig. 19.20). This value of Rg means that, on average, the coils rotate like hollow spheres of radius 5.6 nm and mass equal to the molecular mass. The model of a randomly coiled molecule is still an approximation, even after the bond angles have been restricted, because it does not take into account the impossibility of two or more atoms occupying the same place. Such self-avoidance tends to swell the coil, so (in the absence of solvent effects) it is better to regard Rrms and Rg as lower bounds to the actual values. D F N 3 A C D F 1 − cos θ 1 + cos θ A C 19.9 THE STRUCTURE AND STABILITY OF SYNTHETIC POLYMERS 673 19.9 The structure and stability of synthetic polymers Synthetic polymers are classified broadly as elastomers, fibres, and plastics, depending on their crystallinity, the degree of three-dimensional long-range order attained in the solid state. An elastomer is a flexible polymer that can expand or contract easily upon application of an external force. Elastomers are polymers with numerous crosslinks that pull them back into their original shape when a stress is removed. A perfect elastomer, a polymer in which the internal energy is independent of the extension of the random coil, can be modelled as a freely jointed chain. We saw in Section 19.8b that the contraction of an extended chain to a random coil is spontaneous in the sense that it corresponds to an increase in entropy; the entropy change of the surroundings is zero because no energy is released when the coil forms. In the following Justification we also see that the restoring force, F, of a one-dimensional perfect elastomer is F = ln ν = n/N (19.37a) where N is the total number of bonds of length l and the polymer is stretched or compressed by nl. This function is plotted in Fig. 19.21. At low extensions, when ν << 1: F ≈ = (19.37b) and the sample obeys Hooke’s law: the restoring force is proportional to the displacement (which is proportional to n). For small displacements, therefore, the whole coil shakes with simple harmonic motion. Justification 19.6 Hooke’s law The work done on an elastomer when it is extended through a distance dx is Fdx, where F is the restoring force. The change in internal energy is therefore dU = TdS − pdV + Fdx It follows that T,V = T T,V + F In a perfect elastomer, as in a perfect gas, the internal energy is independent of the dimensions (at constant temperature), so (∂U/∂x)T,V = 0. The restoring force is therefore F = −T T,V If now we substitute eqn 19.34 into this expression (we evade problems arising from the constraint of constant volume by supposing that the sample contracts laterally as it is stretched), we obtain F = − T,V = T,V = ln as in eqn 19.37a. A fibreis a polymeric material that owes its strength to interactions between chains. One example is nylon-66 (Fig. 19.22). Under certain conditions, nylon-66 can be D E F 1 + ν 1 − ν A B C kT 2l D E F ∂S ∂ν A B C T Nl D E F ∂S ∂n A B C T l D E F ∂S ∂x A B C D E F ∂S ∂x A B C D E F ∂U ∂x A B C nkT Nl νkT l D F 1 + ν 1 − ν A C kT 2l -6 -4 -2 0 2 4 6 -1 -0.5 0 0.5 1 /= n N FkTl/(/2) Hooke’s law n Fig. 19.21 The restoring force, F, of a onedimensional perfect elastomer. For small strains, F is linearly proportional to the extension, corresponding to Hooke’s law. N N O H H O O N N N O H H O OH Fig. 19.22 A fragment of two nylon-66 polymer chains showing the pattern of hydrogen bonds that are responsible for the cohesion between the chains. 674 19 MATERIALS 1: MACROMOLECULES AND AGGREGATES prepared in a state of high crystallinity, in which hydrogen bonding between the amide links of neighbouring chains results in an ordered array. A plastic is a polymer that can attain only a limited degree of crystallinity and as a result is neither as strong as a fibre nor as flexible as an elastomer. Certain materials, such as nylon-66, can be prepared either as a fibre or as a plastic. A sample of plastic nylon-66 may be visualized as consisting of crystalline hydrogen-bonded regions of varying size interspersed amongst amorphous, random coil regions. A single type of polymer may exhibit more than one characteristic, for to display fibrous character, the polymers need to be aligned; if the chains are not aligned, then the substance may be plastic. That is the case with nylon, poly(vinyl chloride), and the siloxanes. The crystallinity of synthetic polymers can be destroyed by thermal motion at sufficiently high temperatures. This change in crystallinity may be thought of as a kind of intramolecular melting from a crystalline solid to a more fluid random coil. Polymer melting also occurs at a specific melting temperature, Tm, which increases with the strength and number of intermolecular interactions in the material. Thus, polyethylene, which has chains that interact only weakly in the solid, has Tm = 414 K and nylon-66 fibres, in which there are strong hydrogen bonds between chains, has Tm = 530 K. High melting temperatures are desirable in most practical applications involving fibres and plastics. All synthetic polymers undergo a transition from a state of high to low chain mobility at the glass transition temperature, Tg. To visualize the glass transition, we consider what happens to an elastomer as we lower its temperature. There is sufficient energy available at normal temperatures for limited bond rotation to occur and the flexible chains writhe. At lower temperatures, the amplitudes of the writhing motion decrease until a specific temperature, Tg, is reached at which motion is frozen completely and the sample forms a glass. Glass transition temperatures well below 300 K are desirable in elastomers that are to be used at normal temperatures. Both the glass transition temperature and the melting temperature of a polymer may be measured by differential scanning calorimetry (Impact I2.1). Because the motion of the segments of a polymer chain increase at the glass transition temperature, Tg may also be determined from a plot of the specific volume of a polymer (the reciprocal of its mass density) against temperature (Fig. 19.23). IMPACT ON TECHNOLOGY I19.2 Conducting polymers We have just seen how the structure of a polymer chain affects its mechanical and thermal properties. Now we consider the electrical properties of synthetic polymers. Most of the macromolecules and self-assembled structures considered in this chapter are insulators, or very poor electrical conductors. However, a variety of newly developed macromolecular materials have electrical conductivities that rival those of silicon-based semiconductors and even metallic conductors. We examine one example in detail: conducting polymers, in which extensively conjugated double bonds facilitate electron conduction along the polymer chain. The Nobel Prize in chemistry was awarded in 2000 to A.J. Heeger, A.J. McDiarmid, and H. Shirakawa for their pioneering work in the synthesis and characterization of conducting polymers. One example of a conducting polymer is polyacetylene (Fig. 19.24). Whereas the delocalized π bonds do suggest that electrons can move up and down the chain, the electrical conductivity of polyacetylene increases significantly when it is partially oxidized by I2 and other strong oxidants. The product is a polaron, a partially localized cation radical that does not delocalize but rather travels through the chain, as shown inFig.19.24.Oxidationofthepolymerbyonemoreequivalentformseitherbipolarons, a di-cation that moves as a unit through the chain, or solitons, two separate cation Specificvolume Temperature Tg Fig. 19.23 The variation of specific volume with temperature of a synthetic polymer. The glass transition temperature, Tg, is at the point of intersection of extrapolations of the two linear parts of the curve. + . + . + . Oxidation Fig. 19.24 The mechanism of migration of a partially localized cation radical, or polaron, in polyacetylene. Comment 19.2 As we shall discuss further in Chapter 20, a metallic conductor is a substance with an electrical conductivity that decreases as the temperature is raised. A semiconductor is a substance with an electrical conductivity that increases as the temperature is raised. 19.10 THE STRUCTURE OF PROTEINS 675 radicals that move independently. Polarons and solitons contribute to the mechanism of charge conduction in polyacetylene. Conducting polymers are slightly better electrical conductors than silicon semiconductors but are far worse than metallic conductors. They are currently used in a number of devices, such as electrodes in batteries, electrolytic capacitors, and sensors. Recent studies of photon emission by conducting polymers may lead to new technologies for light-emitting diodes and flat-panel displays. Conducting polymers also show promise as molecular wires that can be incorporated into nanometre-sized electronic devices. 19.10 The structure of proteins A protein is a polypeptide composed of linked α-amino acids, NH2CHRCOOH, where R is one of about 20 groups. For a protein to function correctly, it needs to have a well defined conformation. For example, an enzyme has its greatest catalytic efficiency only when it is in a specific conformation. The amino acid sequence of a protein contains the necessary information to create the active conformation of the protein from a newly synthesized random coil. However, the prediction of the conformation from the primary structure, the so-called protein folding problem, is extraordinarily difficult and is still the focus of much research. (a) The Corey–Pauling rules The origin of the secondary structures of proteins is found in the rules formulated by Linus Pauling and Robert Corey in 1951. The essential feature is the stabilization of structures by hydrogen bonds involving the peptide link. The latter can act both as a donor of the H atom (the NH part of the link) and as an acceptor (the CO part). The Corey–Pauling rules are as follows (Fig. 19.25): 1 The four atoms of the peptide link lie in a relatively rigid plane. The planarity of the link is due to delocalization of π electrons over the O, C, and N atoms and the maintenance of maximum overlap of their p orbitals. 2 The N, H, and O atoms of a hydrogen bond lie in a straight line (with displacements of H tolerated up to not more than 30° from the N-O vector). 3 All NH and CO groups are engaged in hydrogen bonding. The rules are satisfied by two structures. One, in which hydrogen bonding between peptide links leads to a helical structure, is a helix, which can be arranged as either a right- or a left-handed screw. The other, in which hydrogen bonding between peptide links leads to a planar structure, is a sheet; this form is the secondary structure of the protein fibroin, the constituent of silk. (b) Conformational energy ApolypeptidechainadoptsaconformationcorrespondingtoaminimumGibbsenergy, which depends on the conformational energy, the energy of interaction between different parts of the chain, and the energy of interaction between the chain and surrounding solvent molecules. In the aqueous environment of biological cells, the outer surface of a protein molecule is covered by a mobile sheath of water molecules, and its interior contains pockets of water molecules. These water molecules play an important role in determining the conformation that the chain adopts through hydrophobic interactions and hydrogen bonding to amino acids in the chain. The simplest calculations of the conformational energy of a polypeptide chain ignore entropy and solvent effects and concentrate on the total potential energy of all the H H H R R C C C N O 122° 116° 123.5° 102 145.5 132.5 124 151 Rotational freedom Rotational freedom Fig. 19.25 The dimensions that characterize the peptide link (bonds in picometres). The C-NH-CO-C atoms define a plane (the C-N bond has partial double-bond character), but there is rotational freedom around the C-CO and N–C bonds. 676 19 MATERIALS 1: MACROMOLECULES AND AGGREGATES N O C C f R N H C C H y R O NC O O C NC Fig. 19.26 The definition of the torsional angles ψ and φ between two peptide units. In this case (an α-l-polypeptide) the chain has been drawn in its all-trans form, with ψ = φ = 180°. interactions between nonbonded atoms. For example, these calculations predict that a right-handed α helix of L-amino acids is marginally more stable than a left-handed helix of the same amino acids. To calculate the energy of a conformation, we need to make use of many of the molecular interactions described in Chapter 18, and also of some additional interactions: 1 Bond stretching. Bonds are not rigid, and it may be advantageous for some bonds to stretch and others to be compressed slightly as parts of the chain press against one another. If we liken the bond to a spring, then the potential energy takes the form of Hooke’s law Vstretch = 1 –2kstretch(R − Re)2 (19.38) where Re is the equilibrium bond length and kstretch is the force constant, a measure of the stiffness of the bond in question. 2 Bond bending. An O-C-H bond angle (or some other angle) may open out or close in slightly to enable the molecule as a whole to fit together better. If the equilibrium bond angle is θe, we write Vbend = 1 –2kbend(θ − θe)2 (19.39) where kbend is the force constant, a measure of how difficult it is to change the bond angle. Self-test 19.8 Theoretical studies have estimated that the lumiflavin isoalloazine ring system has an energy minimum at the bending angle of 15°, but that it requires only 8.5 kJ mol−1 to increase the angle to 30°. If there are no other compensating interactions, what is the force constant for lumiflavin bending? [6.27 × 10−23 J deg−2 , equivalent to 37.7 J mol−1 deg−2 ] 3 Bond torsion. There is a barrier to internal rotation of one bond relative to another (just like the barrier to internal rotation in ethane). Because the planar peptide link is relatively rigid, the geometry of a polypeptide chain can be specified by the two angles that two neighbouring planar peptide links make to each other. Figure 19.26 shows the two angles φ and ψ commonly used to specify this relative orientation. The sign convention is that a positive angle means that the front atom must be rotated clockwise to bring it into an eclipsed position relative to the rear atom. For an all-trans form of the chain, all φ and ψ are 180°. A helix is obtained when all the φ are equal and when all the ψ are equal. For a right-handed helix, all φ = −57° and all ψ = −47°. For a left-handed helix, both angles are positive. The torsional contribution to the total potential energy is Vtorsion = A(1 + cos 3φ) + B(1 + cos 3ψ) (19.40) in which A and B are constants of the order of 1 kJ mol−1 . Because only two angles are needed to specify the conformation of a helix, and they range from −180° to +180°, the torsionalpotentialenergyoftheentiremoleculecanberepresentedonaRamachandran plot, a contour diagram in which one axis represents φ and the other represents ψ. 4 Interaction between partial charges. If the partial charges qi and qj on the atoms i andjareknown,aCoulombiccontributionoftheform1/rcanbeincluded(Section18.3): VCoulomb = (19.41) qiqj 4πεr 19.10 THE STRUCTURE OF PROTEINS 677 where ε is the permittivity of the medium in which the charges are embedded. Charges of −0.28e and +0.28e are assigned to N and H, respectively, and −0.39e and +0.39e to O and C, respectively. The interaction between partial charges does away with the need to take dipole–dipole interactions into account, for they are taken care of by dealing with each partial charge explicitly. 5 Dispersive and repulsive interactions. The interaction energy of two atoms separated by a distance r (which we know once φ and ψ are specified) can be given by the Lennard-Jones (12,6) form (Section 18.5): VLJ = − (19.42) 6 Hydrogen bonding. In some models of structure, the interaction between partial charges is judged to take into account the effect of hydrogen bonding. In other models, hydrogen bonding is added as another interaction of the form VH bonding = − (19.43) The total potential energy of a given conformation (φ,ψ) can be calculated by summing the contributions given by eqns 19.38–19.43 for all bond angles (including torsional angles) and pairs of atoms in the molecule. The procedure is known as a molecular mechanics simulation and is automated in commercially available molecular modelling software. For large molecules, plots of potential energy against bond distance or bond angle often show several local minima and a global minimum (Fig. 19.27). The software packages include schemes for modifying the locations of the atoms and searching for these minima systematically. The structure corresponding to the global minimum of a molecular mechanics simulation is a snapshot of the molecule at T = 0 because only the potential energy is included in the calculation; contributions to the total energy from kinetic energy are excluded. In a molecular dynamics simulation, the molecule is set in motion by heating it to a specified temperature, as described in Section 17.6b. The possible trajectories of all atoms under the influence of the intermolecular potentials correspond to the conformations that the molecule can sample at the temperature of the simulation. At very low temperatures, the molecule cannot overcome some of the potential energy barriers given by eqns 19.38–19.43, atomic motion is restricted, and only a few conformations are possible. At high temperatures, more potential energy barriers can be overcome and more conformations are possible. Therefore, molecular dynamics calculations are useful tools for the visualization of the flexibility of polymers. (c) Helices and sheets A right-handed a-helix is illustrated in Fig. 19.28. Each turn of the helix contains 3.6 amino acid residues, so the period of the helix corresponds to 5 turns (18 residues). The pitch of a single turn (the distance between points separated by 360°) is 544 pm. The N-H···O bonds lie parallel to the axis and link every fourth group (so residue i is linked to residues i − 4 and i + 4). All the R groups point away from the major axis of the helix. Figure 19.29 shows the Ramachandran plots for the helical form of polypeptide chains formed from the nonchiral amino acid glycine (R = H) and the chiral amino acid l-alanine (R = CH3). The glycine map is symmetrical, with minima of equal depth at φ = −80°, ψ = +90° and at φ = +80°, ψ = −90°. In contrast, the map for l-alanine is unsymmetrical, and there are three distinct low-energy conformations (marked I, II, III). The minima of regions I and II lie close to the angles typical of right- and F r10 E r12 D r6 C r12 Parameter representing conformation Molecularpotentialenergy Local minima Global minimum Fig. 19.27 For large molecules, a plot of potential energy against the molecular geometry often shows several local minima and a global minimum. Fig. 19.28 The polypeptide α helix, with poly-l-glycine as an example. Carbon atoms are shown in green, with nitrogen in blue, oxygen in red, and hydrogen atoms in grey. There are 3.6 residues per turn, and a translation along the helix of 150 pm per residue, giving a pitch of 540 pm. The diameter (ignoring side chains) is about 600 pm. 678 19 MATERIALS 1: MACROMOLECULES AND AGGREGATES left-handed helices, but the former has a lower minimum. This result is consistent with the observation that polypeptides of the naturally occurring L-amino acids tend to form right-handed helices. A b-sheet (also called the b-pleatedsheet) is formed by hydrogen bonding between two extended polypeptide chains (large absolute values of the torsion angles φ and ψ). Some of the R groups point above and some point below the sheet. Two types of structures can be distinguished from the pattern of hydrogen bonding between the constituent chains. In an anti-parallel b-sheet (Fig. 19.30a), φ = −139°, ψ = 113°, and the N-H····O atoms of the hydrogen bonds form a straight line. This arrangement is a consequence of the antiparallel arrangement of the chains: every N-H bond on one chain is aligned with a C-O bond from another chain. Antiparallel β-sheets are very common in proteins. In a parallel b-sheet (Fig. 19.30b), φ = −119°, ψ = 113°, and the N-H····O atoms of the hydrogen bonds are not perfectly aligned. This arrangement is a result of the parallel arrangement of the chains: each N-H bond on one chain is aligned with a N-H bond of another chain and, as a result, each C-O bond of one chain is aligned with a C-O bond of another chain. These structures are not common in proteins. Circulardichroism(CD)spectroscopy(Section14.2)providesagreatdealofinformation about the secondary structure of polypeptides. Consider a helical polypeptide. Not only are the individual monomer units chiral, but so is the helix. Therefore, we expect the α-helix to have a unique CD spectrum. Because β-sheets and random coils also have distinguishable spectral features (Fig. 19.31), circular dichroism is a very important technique for the study of protein conformation. (d) Higher-order structures Covalent and non-covalent interactions may cause polypeptide chains with well defined secondary structures to fold into tertiary structures. Subunits with well defined tertiary structures may interact further to form quaternary structures. Although we do not know all the rules that govern protein folding, a few general conclusions may be drawn from X-ray diffraction studies of water-soluble natural proteins and synthetic polypeptides. In an aqueous environment, the chains fold in such a way as to place nonpolar R groups in the interior (which is often not very accessible to solvent) and charged R groups on the surface (in direct contact with the polar solvent). A wide variety of structures can result from these broad rules. Among them, a four-helixbundle(Fig. 19.32), which is found in proteins such as cytochrome b562 (an electron transport protein), forms when each helix has a nonpolar region along its length. The four nonpolar regions pack together to form a nonpolar interior. (a) (b) -180° 180°0 y f 180° -180° 0 -180° 180°0 y f 180° -180° 0 Fig. 19.29 Contour plots of potential energy against the torsional angles ψ and φ, also known as Ramachandran plots, for (a) a glycyl residue of a polypeptide chain and (b) an alanyl residue. The darker the shading is, the lower the potential energy. The glycyl diagram is symmetrical, but regions I and II in the correspond to right- and left-handed helices, are unsymmetrical, and the minimum in region I lies lower than that in region II. (After D.A. Brant and P.J. Flory, J. Mol. Biol. 23, 47 (1967).) Comment 19.3 The web site contains links to sites where you may predict the secondary structure of a polypeptide by molecular mechanics simulations. There are also links to sites where you may visualize the structures of proteins and nucleic acids that have been obtained by experimental and theoretical methods. (a) (b) Fig. 19.30 The two types of β-sheets: (a) antiparallel (φ = −139°, ψ = 113°), in which the N-H-O atoms of the hydrogen bonds form a straight-line; (b) parallel (φ = −119°, ψ = 113° in which the N-H····O atoms of the hydrogen bonds are not perfectly aligned. 19.11 THE STRUCTURE OF NUCLEIC ACIDS 679 Similarly, interconnected β-sheets may interact to form a b-barrel (Fig. 19.33), the interior of which is populated by nonpolar R groups and which has an exterior rich in charged residues. The retinol-binding protein of blood plasma, which is responsible for transporting vitamin A, is an example of a β-barrel structure. Factors that promote the folding of proteins include covalent disulfide (-S-S-) links, Coulombic interactions between ions (which depend on the degree of protonation of groups and therefore on the pH), hydrogen bonding, van der Waals interactions, and hydrophobic interactions (Section 18.4g). The clustering of nonpolar, hydrophobic, amino acids into the interior of a protein is driven primarily by hydrophobic interactions. 19.11 The structure of nucleic acids Nucleic acids are key components of the mechanism of storage and transfer of genetic information in biological cells. Deoxyribonucleic acid (DNA) contains the instructions for protein synthesis, which is carried out by different forms of ribonucleic acid (RNA). In this section, we discuss the main structural features of DNA and RNA. Both DNA and RNA are polynucleotides (2), in which base–sugar–phosphate units are linked by phosphodiester bonds. In RNA the sugar is β-d-ribose and in DNA it is β-d-2-deoxyribose (as shown in 2). The most common bases are adenine (A, 3), cytosine (C, 4), guanine (G, 5), thymine (T, found in DNA only, 6), and uracil (U, found in RNA only, 7). At physiological pH, each phosphate group of the chain carries a Wavelength, /nm helix sheet Random coil 180 250 LR- 0 4 2 -2 -4 -6 a b ee l Fig. 19.31 Representative CD spectra of polypeptides. Random coils, α-helices, and β-sheets have different CD features in the spectral region where the peptide link absorbs. Fig. 19.32 A four-helix bundle forms from the interactions between nonpolar aminoacids on the surfaces of each helix, with the polar aminoacids exposed to the aqueous environment of the solvent. Fig. 19.33 Eight anti-parallel β-sheets, each represented by a purple arrow and linked by short random coils fold together as a β-barrel. Nonpolar aminoacids are in the interior of the barrel. 680 19 MATERIALS 1: MACROMOLECULES AND AGGREGATES negative charge and the bases are deprotonated and neutral. This charge distribution leads to two important properties. One is that the polynucleotide chain is a polyelectrolyte, a macromolecule with many different charged sites, with a large and negative overall surface charge. The second is that the bases can interact by hydrogen bonding, as shown for A-T (8) and C-G base pairs (9). The secondary and tertiary structures of DNA and RNA arise primarily from the pattern of this hydrogen bonding between bases of one or more chains. In DNA, two polynucleotide chains wind around each other to form a double helix (Fig. 19.34). The chains are held together by links involving A-T and C-G base pairs that lie parallel to each other and perpendicular to the major axis of the helix. The structure is stabilized further by interactions between the planar π systems of the bases. In B-DNA, the most common form of DNA found in biological cells, the helix is right-handed with a diameter of 2.0 nm and a pitch of 3.4 nm. Long stretches of DNA can fold further into a variety of tertiary structures. Two examples are shown in Fig. 19.35. Supercoiled DNA is found in the chromosome and can be visualized as the twisting of closed circular DNA (ccDNA), much like the twisting of a rubber band. The extra -OH group in β-D-ribose imparts enough steric strain to a polynucleotide chain so that stable double helices cannot form in RNA. Therefore, RNA exists primarily as single chains that can fold into complex structures by formation of A-U and G-C base pairs. One example of this structural complexity is the structure of transfer RNA (tRNA), shown schematically in Fig. 19.36 in which base-paired regions are connected by loops and coils. Transfer RNAs help assemble polypeptide chains during protein synthesis in the cell. T A C G T A G C Fig. 19.34 DNA double helix, in which two polynucleotide chains are linked together by hydrogen bonds between adenine (A) and thymine (T) and between cytosine (C) and guanine (G). Closed circular DNA Supercoiled DNA = Fig. 19.35 A long section of DNA may form closed circular DNA (ccDNA) by covalent linkage of the two ends of the chain. Twisting of ccDNA leads to the formation of supercoiled DNA. Fig. 19.36 Structure of a transfer RNA (tRNA). 19.12 THE STABILITY OF PROTEINS AND NUCLEIC ACIDS 681 19.12 The stability of proteins and nucleic acids The loss of their natural conformation by proteins and nucleic acids is called denaturation. It can be achieved by changing the temperature or by adding chemical agents. Cooking is an example of thermal denaturation. When eggs are cooked, the protein albumin is denatured irreversibly, collapsing into a structure that resembles a random coil. One example of chemical denaturation is the ‘permanent waving’ of hair, which is a result of the reorganization of the protein keratin in hair. Disulfide cross-links between the chains of keratin render the protein and, hence hair fibres, inflexible. Chemical reduction of the disulfide bonds unravels keratin, and allows hair to be shaped. Oxidation re-forms the disulfide bonds and sets the new shape. The ‘permanence’ is only temporary, however, because the structure of newly formed hair is genetically controlled. Other means of chemically denaturing a protein include the addition of compounds that form stronger hydrogen bonds than those within a helix or sheet. One example is urea, which competes for the NH and CO groups of a polypeptide. The action of acids or bases, which can protonate or deprotonate groups involved in hydrogen bonding or change the Coulombic interactions that determine the conformation of a protein, can also result in denaturation. Closer examination of thermal denaturation reveals some of the chemical factors that determine protein and nucleic acid stability. Thermal denaturation is similar to the melting of synthetic polymers (Section 19.9). Denaturation is a cooperative process in the sense that the biopolymer becomes increasingly more susceptible to denaturation once the process begins. This cooperativity is observed as a sharp step in a plot of fraction of unfolded polymer versus temperature (Impact I16.1). The melting temperature, Tm, is the temperature at which the fraction of unfolded polymer is 0.5 (Fig. 19.37). A DNA molecule is held together by hydrogen bonding interactions between bases of different chains and by base-stacking, in which dispersion interactions bring together the planar π systems of bases. Each G-C base pair has three hydrogen bonds whereas each A-T base pair has only two. Furthermore, experiments show that stacking interactions are stronger between C-G base pairs than between A-T base pairs. It follows that two factors render DNA sequences rich in C-G base pairs more stable than sequences rich in A-T base pairs: more hydrogen bonds between the bases and stronger stacking interactions between base pairs. Proteins are relatively unstable towards chemical and thermal denaturation. For example, Tm = 320 K for ribonuclease T1 (an enzyme that cleaves RNA in the cell), which is not far above the temperature at which the enzyme must operate (close to body temperature, 310 K). More surprisingly, the Gibbs energy for the unfolding of ribonuclease T1 at pH 7.0 and 298 K is only 19.5 kJ mol−1 , which is comparable to the energy required to break a single hydrogen bond (about 20 kJ mol−1 ). Therefore, unlike DNA, the stability of a protein does not increase in a simple way with the number of hydrogen bonding interactions. While the reasons for the low stability of proteins are not known, the answer probably lies in a delicate balance of all intra- and intermolecular interactions that allow a protein to fold into its active conformation, as discussed in Section 19.10. Self-assembly Much of the material discussed in this chapter also applies to aggregates of particles that form by self-assembly, the spontaneous formation of complex structures of molecules or macromolecules held together by molecular interactions, such as Temperature Fractionofunfoldedprotein Tm 0 0.5 1 Fig. 19.37 A protein unfolds as the temperature of the sample increases. The sharp step in the plot of fraction of unfolded protein against temperature indicated that the transition is cooperative. The melting temperature, Tm, is the temperature at which the fraction of unfolded polymer is 0.5. 682 19 MATERIALS 1: MACROMOLECULES AND AGGREGATES Coulombic, dispersion, hydrogen bonding, or hydrophobic interactions. We have already encountered a few examples of self-assembly, such as the formation of liquid crystals (Impact I6.1), of protein quaternary structures from two or more polypeptide chains, and of a DNA double helix from two polynucleotide chains. Now we concentrate on the specific properties of additional self-assembled systems, including small aggregates that are at the heart of detergent action and extended sheets like those forming biological cell membranes. 19.13 Colloids A colloid, or disperse phase, is a dispersion of small particles of one material in another. In this context, ‘small’ means something less than about 500 nm in diameter (about the wavelength of visible light). In general, colloidal particles are aggregates of numerous atoms or molecules, but are too small to be seen with an ordinary optical microscope. They pass through most filter papers, but can be detected by lightscattering and sedimentation. (a) Classification and preparation The name given to the colloid depends on the two phases involved. A sol is a dispersion of a solid in a liquid (such as clusters of gold atoms in water) or of a solid in a solid (such as ruby glass, which is a gold-in-glass sol, and achieves its colour by light scattering). An aerosol is a dispersion of a liquid in a gas (like fog and many sprays) or a solid in a gas (such as smoke): the particles are often large enough to be seen with a microscope. An emulsion is a dispersion of a liquid in a liquid (such as milk). Afurtherclassificationofcolloidsisaslyophilic,orsolventattracting,andlyophobic, solvent repelling. If the solvent is water, the terms hydrophilic and hydrophobic, respectively, are used instead. Lyophobic colloids include the metal sols. Lyophilic colloids generally have some chemical similarity to the solvent, such as -OH groups able to form hydrogen bonds. A gel is a semirigid mass of a lyophilic sol in which all the dispersion medium has penetrated into the sol particles. The preparation of aerosols can be as simple as sneezing (which produces an imperfect aerosol). Laboratory and commercial methods make use of several techniques. Material (for example, quartz) may be ground in the presence of the dispersion medium. Passing a heavy electric current through a cell may lead to the sputtering (crumbling)ofanelectrodeintocolloidalparticles.Arcingbetweenelectrodesimmersed in the support medium also produces a colloid. Chemical precipitation sometimes results in a colloid. A precipitate (for example, silver iodide) already formed may be dispersed by the addition of a peptizing agent (for example, potassium iodide). Clays may be peptized by alkalis, the OH− ion being the active agent. Emulsionsarenormallypreparedbyshakingthetwocomponentstogethervigorously, although some kind of emulsifying agent usually has to be added to stabilize the product. This emulsifying agent may be a soap (the salt of a long-chain carboxylic acid) or other surfactant (surface active) species, or a lyophilic sol that forms a protective film around the dispersed phase. In milk, which is an emulsion of fats in water, the emulsifying agent is casein, a protein containing phosphate groups. It is clear from the formation of cream on the surface of milk that casein is not completely successful in stabilizing milk: the dispersed fats coalesce into oily droplets which float to the surface. This coagulation may be prevented by ensuring that the emulsion is dispersed very finely initially: intense agitation with ultrasonics brings this dispersion about, the product being ‘homogenized’ milk. One way to form an aerosol is to tear apart a spray of liquid with a jet of gas. The dispersal is aided if a charge is applied to the liquid, for then electrostatic repulsions 19.13 COLLOIDS 683 help to blast it apart into droplets. This procedure may also be used to produce emulsions, for the charged liquid phase may be directed into another liquid. Colloids are often purified by dialysis (Impact I5.2). The aim is to remove much (but not all, for reasons explained later) of the ionic material that may have accompanied their formation. A membrane (for example, cellulose) is selected that is permeable to solvent and ions, but not to the colloid particles. Dialysis is very slow, and is normally accelerated by applying an electric field and making use of the charges carried by many colloidal particles; the technique is then called electrodialysis. (b) Structure and stability Colloids are thermodynamically unstable with respect to the bulk. This instability can be expressed thermodynamically by noting that because the change in Gibbs energy, dG, when the surface area of the sample changes by dσ at constant temperature and pressure is dG = γdσ, where γ is the interfacial surface tension (Section 18.7a), it follows that dG < 0 if dσ < 0. The survival of colloids must therefore be a consequence of the kinetics of collapse: colloids are thermodynamically unstable but kinetically nonlabile. At first sight, even the kinetic argument seems to fail: colloidal particles attract each other over large distances, so there is a long-range force that tends to condense them into a single blob. The reasoning behind this remark is as follows. The energy of attraction between two individual atoms i and j separated by a distance Rij, one in each colloidal particle, varies with their separation as 1/R6 ij (Section 18.4). The sum of all these pairwise interactions, however, decreases only as approximately 1/R2 (the precise variation depending on the shape of the particles and their closeness), where R is the separation of the centres of the particles. The sum has a much longer range than the 1/R6 dependence characteristic of individual particles and small molecules. Several factors oppose the long-range dispersion attraction. For example, there may be a protective film at the surface of the colloid particles that stabilizes the interface and cannot be penetrated when two particles touch. Thus the surface atoms of a platinum sol in water react chemically and are turned into -Pt(OH)3H3, and this layer encases the particle like a shell. A fat can be emulsified by a soap because the long hydrocarbon tails penetrate the oil droplet but the carboxylate head groups (or other hydrophilic groups in synthetic detergents) surround the surface, form hydrogen bonds with water, and give rise to a shell of negative charge that repels a possible approach from another similarly charged particle. (c) The electrical double layer A major source of kinetic nonlability of colloids is the existence of an electric charge on the surfaces of the particles. On account of this charge, ions of opposite charge tend to cluster nearby, and an ionic atmosphere is formed, just as for ions (Section 5.9). We need to distinguish two regions of charge. First, there is a fairly immobile layer of ions that adhere tightly to the surface of the colloidal particle, and which may include water molecules (if that is the support medium). The radius of the sphere that captures this rigid layer is called the radius of shear and is the major factor determining the mobility of the particles. The electric potential at the radius of shear relative to its value in the distant, bulk medium is called the zeta potential, ζ, or the electrokineticpotential. Second, the charged unit attracts an oppositely charged atmosphere of mobile ions. The inner shell of charge and the outer ionic atmosphere is called the electrical double layer. The theory of the stability of lyophobic dispersions was developed by B. Derjaguin and L. Landau and independently by E. Verwey and J.T.G. Overbeek, and is known as 684 19 MATERIALS 1: MACROMOLECULES AND AGGREGATES the DLVO theory. It assumes that there is a balance between the repulsive interaction between the charges of the electric double layers on neighbouring particles and the attractive interactions arising from van der Waals interactions between the molecules in the particles. The potential energy arising from the repulsion of double layers on particles of radius a has the form Vrepulsion = + e−s/rD (19.44) where A is a constant, ζ is the zeta potential,1 R is the separation of centres, s is the separation of the surfaces of the two particles (s = R − 2a for spherical particles of radius a), and rD is the thickness of the double layer. This expression is valid for small particles with a thick double layer (a << rD). When the double layer is thin (rD << a), the expression is replaced by Vrepulsion = 1 –2Aaζ2 ln(1 + e−s/rD ) (19.45) In each case, the thickness of the double layer can be estimated from an expression like that derived for the thickness of the ionic atmosphere in the Debye–Hückel theory (eqn 5.80): rD = 1/2 (19.46) where I is the ionic strength of the solution, ρ its mass density, and b7 = 1 mol kg−1 . The potential energy arising from the attractive interaction has the form Vattraction = − (19.47) where B is another constant. The variation of the total potential energy with separation is shown in Fig. 19.38. At high ionic strengths, the ionic atmosphere is dense and the potential shows a secondary minimum at large separations. Aggregation of the particles arising from the stabilizing effect of this secondary minimum is called flocculation. The flocculated material can often be redispersed by agitation because the well is so shallow. Coagulation, the irreversible aggregation of distinct particles into large particles, occurs when the separation of the particles is so small that they enter the primary minimum of the potential energy curve and van der Waals forces are dominant. The ionic strength is increased by the addition of ions, particularly those of high chargetype,sosuchionsactasflocculatingagents.Thisincreaseisthebasisoftheempirical Schulze–Hardyrule, that hydrophobic colloids are flocculated most efficiently by ions of opposite charge type and high charge number. The Al3+ ions in alum are very effective, and are used to induce the congealing of blood. When river water containing colloidal clay flows into the sea, the salt water induces flocculation and coagulation, and is a major cause of silting in estuaries. Metal oxide sols tend to be positively charged whereas sulfur and the noble metals tend to be negatively charged. The primary role of the electric double layer is to confer kinetic non-lability. Colliding colloidal particles break through the double layer and coalesce only if the collision is sufficiently energetic to disrupt the layers of ions and solvating molecules, or if thermal motion has stirred away the surface accumulation of charge. This disruption may occur at high temperatures, which is one reason why sols precipitate B s D F εRT 2ρF2 Ib7 A C Aa2 ζ2 R 1 The actual potential is that of the surface of the particles; there is some danger in identifying it with the zeta potential. See the references in Further reading. r aD << r aD >> Potentialenergy,V Coagulation Flocculation Separation, s Fig. 19.38 The potential energy of interaction as a function of the separation of the centres of the two particles and its variation with the ratio of the particle size to the thickness a of the electric double layer rD. The regions labelled coagulation and flocculation show the dips in the potential energy curves where these processes occur. 19.14 MICELLES AND BIOLOGICAL MEMBRANES 685 when they are heated. The protective role of the double layer is the reason why it is important not to remove all the ions when a colloid is being purified by dialysis, and why proteins coagulate most readily at their isoelectric point. 19.14 Micelles and biological membranes Surfactant molecules or ions can cluster together as micelles, which are colloid-sized clusters of molecules, for their hydrophobic tails tend to congregate, and their hydrophilic heads provide protection (Fig. 19.39). (a) Micelle formation Micelles form only above the critical micelle concentration (CMC) and above the Krafft temperature. The CMC is detected by noting a pronounced change in physical properties of the solution, particularly the molar conductivity (Fig. 19.40). There is no abrupt change in properties at the CMC; rather, there is a transition region corresponding to a range of concentrations around the CMC where physical properties vary smoothly but nonlinearly with the concentration. The hydrocarbon interior of a micelle is like a droplet of oil. Nuclear magnetic resonance shows that the hydrocarbon tails are mobile, but slightly more restricted than in the bulk. Micelles are important in industry and biology on account of their solubilizing function: matter can be transported by water after it has been dissolved in their hydrocarbon interiors. For this reason, micellar systems are used as detergents, for organic synthesis, froth flotation, and petroleum recovery. Non-ionic surfactant molecules may cluster together in clumps of 1000 or more, but ionic species tend to be disrupted by the electrostatic repulsions between head groups and are normally limited to groups of less than about 100. The micelle population is often polydisperse, and the shapes of the individual micelles vary with concentration. Spherical micelles do occur, but micelles are more commonly flattened spheres close to the CMC. Under certain experimental conditions, a liposome may form, with an inward pointing inner surface of molecules surrounded by an outward pointing outer layer (Fig. 19.41). Liposomes may be used to carry nonpolar drug molecules in blood. In concentrated solutions micelles formed from surfactant molecules may take the form of long cylinders and stack together in reasonably close-packed (hexagonal) arrays. These orderly arrangements of micelles are called lyotropic mesomorphs and, more colloquially, ‘liquid crystalline phases’. The enthalpy of micelle formation reflects the contributions of interactions between micelle chains within the micelles and between the polar head groups and the surrounding medium. Consequently, enthalpies of micelle formation display no readily discernible pattern and may be positive (endothermic) or negative (exothermic). Many non-ionic micelles form endothermically, with ∆H of the order of 10 kJ per mole of surfactant. That such micelles do form above the CMC indicates that the entropy change accompanying their formation must then be positive, and measurements suggest a value of about +140 J K−1 mol−1 at room temperature. The fact that the entropy change is positive even though the molecules are clustering together shows that hydrophobic interactions (Section 18.*) are important in the formation of micelles. (b) Membrane formation Some micelles at concentrations well above the CMC form extended parallel sheets, called lamellar micelles, two molecules thick. The individual molecules lie perpendicular to the sheets, with hydrophilic groups on the outside in aqueous solution and Fig. 19.39 A schematic version of a spherical micelle. The hydrophilic groups are represented by spheres and the hydrophobic hydrocarbon chains are represented by the stalks; these stalks are mobile. Concentration of surfactant CMC Molar conductivity Surface tension Osmotic pressure Physicalproperty Fig. 19.40 The typical variation of some physical properties of an aqueous solution of sodium dodecylsulfate close to the critical micelle concentration (CMC). Fig. 19.41 The cross-sectional structure of a spherical liposome. 686 19 MATERIALS 1: MACROMOLECULES AND AGGREGATES on the inside in nonpolar media. Such lamellar micelles show a close resemblance to biological membranes, and are often a useful model on which to base investigations of biological structures. Although lamellar micelles are convenient models of cell membranes, actual membranes are highly sophisticated structures. The basic structural element of a membrane is a phospholipid, such as phosphatidyl choline (10), which contains long hydrocarbon chains (typically in the range C14–C24) and a variety of polar groups, such as -CH2CH2N(CH3)3 + in (10). The hydrophobic chains stack together to form an extensive bilayer about 5 nm across. The lipid molecules form layers instead of micelles because the hydrocarbon chains are too bulky to allow packing into nearly spherical clusters. The bilayer is a highly mobile structure, as shown by EPR studies with spin-labelled phospholipids (Impact I15.2). Not only are the hydrocarbon chains ceaselessly twisting and turning in the region between the polar groups, but the phospholipid and cholesterol molecules migrate over the surface. It is better to think of the membrane as a viscous fluid rather than a permanent structure, with a viscosity about 100 times that of water. In common with diffusional behaviour in general (see Section 21.*), the average distance a phospholipid molecule diffuses is proportional to the square-root of the time; more precisely, for a molecule confined to a two-dimensional plane, the average distance travelled in a time t is equal to (4Dt)1/2 . Typically, a phospholipid molecule migrates through about 1 µm (the diameter of a cell) in about 1 min. All lipid bilayers undergo a transition from a state of high to low chain mobility at a temperature that depends on the structure of the lipid. To visualize the transition, we consider what happens to a membrane as we lower its temperature (Fig. 19.42). There is sufficient energy available at normal temperatures for limited bond rotation to occur and the flexible chains writhe. However, the membrane is still highly organized in the sense that the bilayer structure does not come apart and the system is best described as a liquid crystal (Fig. 19.42a). At lower temperatures, the amplitudes of the writhing motion decrease until a specific temperature is reached at which motion is largely frozen. The membrane is said to exist as a gel (Fig. 19.42b). Biological membranes exist as liquid crystals at physiological temperatures. Phase transitions in membranes are often observed as ‘melting’ from gel to liquid crystal by differential scanning calorimetry (Impact I2.1). The data show relations between the structure of the lipid and the melting temperature. For example, the melting temperature increases with the length of the hydrophobic chain of the lipid. This correlation is reasonable, as we expect longer chains to be held together more strongly by hydrophobic interactions than shorter chains. It follows that stabilization of the gel phase in membranes of lipids with long chains results in relatively high melting temperatures. On the other hand, any structural elements that prevent alignment of the hydrophobic chains in the gel phase lead to low melting temperatures. Indeed, lipids containing unsaturated chains, those containing some C=C bonds, form membranes Comment 19.4 The web site contains links to databases of thermodynamic properties of lipids. (b)(a) Fig. 19.42 A depiction of the variation with temperature of the flexibility of hydrocarbon chains in a lipid bilayer. (a) At physiological temperature, the bilayer exists as a liquid crystal, in which some order exists but the chains writhe. (b) At a specific temperature, the chains are largely frozen and the bilayer is said to exist as a gel. 19.15 SURFACE FILMS 687 Bilayer LeafletLeaflet Complex sugar chain (for recognition) Peripheral protein Integral protein Exterior Interior Fig. 19.43 In the fluid mosaic model of a biological cell membrane, integral proteins diffuse through the lipid bilayer. In the alternative lipid raft model, a number of lipid and cholesterol molecules envelop and transport the protein around the membrane. Compression barrier Mica float Liquid + surfactant Liquid Liquid Fig. 19.44 A schematic diagram of the apparatus used to measure the surface pressure and other characteristics of a surface film. The surfactant is spread on the surface of the liquid in the trough, and then compressed horizontally by moving the compression barrier towards the mica float. The latter is connected to a torsion wire, so the difference in force on either side of the float can be monitored. with lower melting temperatures than those formed from lipids with fully saturated chains, those consisting of C-C bonds only. Interspersed among the phospholipids of biological membranes are sterols, such as cholesterol (11), which is largely hydrophobic but does contain a hydrophilic -OH group. Sterols, which are present in different proportions in different types of cells, prevent the hydrophobic chains of lipids from ‘freezing’ into a gel and, by disrupting the packing of the chains, spread the melting point of the membrane over a range of temperatures. Self-test 19.9 Organisms are capable of biosynthesizing lipids of different composition so that cell membranes have melting temperatures close to the ambient temperature. Why do bacterial and plant cells grown at low temperatures synthesize more phospholipids with unsaturated chains than do cells grown at higher temperatures? [Insertion of lipids with unsaturated chains lowers the plasma membrane’s melting temperature to a value that is close to the lower ambient temperature.] Peripheral proteins are proteins attached to the bilayer. Integral proteins are proteins immersed in the mobile but viscous bilayer. These proteins may span the depth of the bilayer and consist of tightly packed α helices or, in some cases, β sheets containing hydrophobic residues that sit comfortably within the hydrocarbon region of the bilayer. There are two views of the motion of integral proteins in the bilayer. In the fluid mosaic model shown in Fig. 19.43 the proteins are mobile, but their diffusion coefficients are much smaller than those of the lipids. In the lipid raft model, a number of lipid and cholesterol molecules form ordered structures, or ‘rafts’, that envelop proteins and help carry them to specific parts of the cell. The mobility of the bilayer enables it to flow round a molecule close to the outer surface, to engulf it, and incorporate it into the cell by the process of endocytosis. Alternatively, material from the cell interior wrapped in cell membrane may coalesce with the cell membrane itself, which then withdraws and ejects the material in the process of exocytosis. The function of the proteins embedded in the bilayer, though, is to act as devices for transporting matter into and out of the cell in a more subtle manner. By providing hydrophilic channels through an otherwise alien hydrophobic environment, some proteins act as ion channels and ion pumps (Impact I21.2). 19.15 Surface films The compositions of surface layers have been investigated by the simple but technically elegant procedure of slicing thin layers off the surfaces of solutions and analysing their compositions. The physical properties of surface films have also been investigated. Surface films one molecule thick, such as that formed by a surfactant, are called monolayers. When a monolayer has been transferred to a solid support, it is called a Langmuir–Blodgett film, after Irving Langmuir and Katherine Blodgett, who developed experimental techniques for studying them. (a) Surface pressure The principal apparatus used for the study of surface monolayers is a surface film balance (Fig. 19.44). This device consists of a shallow trough and a barrier that can be moved along the surface of the liquid in the trough, and hence compress any monolayer on the surface. Thesurface pressure, π, the difference between the surface 688 19 MATERIALS 1: MACROMOLECULES AND AGGREGATES 40 30 20 10 0 0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1 Surfacepressure,/(mNm)-1 Area per molecule/nm2 Stearic acid Isostearic acid Tri- -cresyl phosphate p p tension of the pure solvent and the solution (π = γ * − γ) is measured by using a torsion wire attached to a strip of mica that rests on the surface and pressing against one edge of the monolayer. The parts of the apparatus that are in touch with liquids are coated in polytetrafluoroethylene to eliminate effects arising from the liquid–solid interface. In an actual experiment, a small amount (about 0.01 mg) of the surfactant under investigation is dissolved in a volatile solvent and then poured on to the surface of the water; the compression barrier is then moved across the surface and the surface pressure exerted on the mica bar is monitored. Some typical results are shown in Fig. 19.45. One parameter obtained from the isotherms is the area occupied by the molecules when the monolayer is closely packed. This quantity is obtained from the extrapolation of the steepest part of the isotherm to the horizontal axis. As can be seen from the illustration, even though stearic acid (12) and isostearic acid (13) are chemically very similar (they differ only in the location of a methyl group at the end of a long hydrocarbon chain), they occupy significantly different areas in the monolayer. Neither, though, occupies as much area as the trip-cresyl phosphate molecule (14), which is like a wide bush rather than a lanky tree. The second feature to note from Fig. 19.45 is that the tri-p-cresyl phosphate isotherm is much less steep than the stearic acid isotherms. This difference indicates that the tri-p-cresyl phosphate film is more compressible than the stearic acid films, which is consistent with their different molecular structures. A third feature of the isotherms is the collapse pressure, the highest surface pressure. When the monolayer is compressed beyond the point represented by the collapse pressure, the monolayer buckles and collapses into a film several molecules thick. As can be seen from the isotherms in Fig. 19.45, stearic acid has a high collapse pressure, but that of tri-p-cresyl phosphate is significantly smaller, indicating a much weaker film. (b) The thermodynamics of surface layers A surfactant is active at the interface between two phases, such as at the interface between hydrophilic and hydrophobic phases. A surfactant accumulates at the interface, and modifies its surface tension and hence the surface pressure. To establish the relation between the concentration of surfactant at a surface and the change in surface tension it brings about, we consider two phases α and β in contact and suppose that the system consists of several components J, each one present in an overall amount nJ. If the components were distributed uniformly through the two phases right up to the interface, which is taken to be a plane of surface area σ, the total Gibbs energy, G, would be the sum of the Gibbs energies of both phases, G = G(α) + G(β). However, the components are not uniformly distributed because one may accumulate at the interface. As a result, the sum of the two Gibbs energies differs from G by an amount called the surface Gibbs energy, G(σ): G(σ) = G − {G(α) + G(β)} (19.48) Similarly, if it is supposed that the concentration of a species J is uniform right up to the interface, then from its volume we would conclude that it contains an amount nJ(α) of J in phase α and an amount nJ(β) in phase β. However, because a species may accumulate at the interface, the total amount of J differs from the sum of these two amounts by nJ(σ) = nJ − {nJ(α) + nJ(β)}. This difference is expressed in terms of the surface excess, ΓJ: ΓJ = (19.49) The surface excess may be either positive (an accumulation of J at the interface) or negative (a deficiency there). nJ(σ) σ Fig. 19.45 The variation of surface pressure with the area occupied by each surfactant molecule. The collapse pressures are indicated by the horizontal dotted lines. 19.15 SURFACE FILMS 689 The relation between the change in surface tension and the composition of a surface (as expressed by the surface excess) was derived by Gibbs. In the following Justification we derive the Gibbs isotherm, between the changes in the chemical potentials of the substances present in the interface and the change in surface tension: dγ = − ∑ J ΓJdµJ (19.50) Justification 19.7 The Gibbs isotherm A general change in G is brought about by changes in T, p, and the nJ: dG = −SdT + Vdp + γdσ + ∑J µJdnJ When this relation is applied to G, G(α), and G(β) we find dG(σ) = −S(σ)dT + γdσ + ∑J µJdnJ(σ) because at equilibrium the chemical potential of each component is the same in every phase, µJ(α) = µJ(β) = µJ(σ). Just as in the discussion of partial molar quantities (Section 5.1), the last equation integrates at constant temperature to G(σ) = γσ + ∑J µJnJ(σ) We are seeking a connection between the change of surface tension dγ and the change of composition at the interface. Therefore, we use the argument that in Section 5.1 led to the Gibbs–Duhem equation (eqn 5.12b), but this time we compare the expression dG(σ) = γdσ + ∑J µJdnJ(σ) (which is valid at constant temperature) with the expression for the same quantity but derived from the preceding equation: dG(σ) = γdσ + σdγ + ∑J µJdnJ(σ) + ∑J nJ(σ)dµJ The comparison implies that, at constant temperature, σdγ + ∑J nJ(σ)dµJ = 0 Division by σ then gives eqn 19.50. Now consider a simplified model of the interface in which the ‘oil’ and ‘water’ phases are separated by a geometrically flat surface. This approximation implies that only the surfactant, S, accumulates at the surface, and hence that Γoil and Γwater are both zero. Then the Gibbs isotherm equation becomes dγ = −ΓSdµS (19.51) For dilute solutions, dµS = RT ln c (19.52) where c is the molar concentration of the surfactant. It follows that dγ = RTΓS at constant temperature, or T = − (19.53) If the surfactant accumulates at the interface, its surface excess is positive and eqn 19.53 implies that (∂γ/∂c)T < 0. That is, the surface tension decreases when a solute accumulates at a surface. Conversely, if the concentration dependence of γ is known, then the surface excess may be predicted and used to infer the area occupied by each surfactant molecule on the surface. RTΓS c D F ∂γ ∂c A C dc c 690 19 MATERIALS 1: MACROMOLECULES AND AGGREGATES IMPACT ON NANOSCIENCE I19.3 Nanofabrication with self-assembled monolayers Nanofabrication is the synthesis of nanodevices, nanometre-sized assemblies of atoms and molecules that can be used in nanotechnological applications, such as those discussed in Impact I9.2. Here we see how molecular self-assembly can be used as the basis for nanofabrication on surfaces . Of current interest are self-assembled monolayers (SAMs), ordered molecular aggregates that form a monolayer of material on a surface. To understand the formation of SAMs, consider exposing molecules such as alkyl thiols RSH, where R represents an alkyl chain, to an Au(0) surface. The thiols react with the surface, forming RS− Au(I) adducts: RSH + Au(0)n → RS− Au(I) · Au(0)n−1 + 1 –2 H2 If R is a sufficiently long chain, van der Waals interactions between the adsorbed RS units lead to the formation of a highly ordered monolayer on the surface, as shown in Fig. 19.46. It is observed that the Gibbs energy of formation of SAMs increases with the length of the alkyl chain, with each methylene group contributing 400–4000 J mol−1 to the overall Gibbs energy of formation. The atomic force microscope (Impact I9.1) can be used to manipulate SAMs into specific shapes on a surface by digging the microscope tip through the alkyl chains, bringing it into contact with the surface and then moving SAMs around the surface. In one application of the technique, enzymes were bound to patterned SAMs. The experiment shows that it is possible to form nanometre-sized reactors that take advantage of the catalytic properties of enzymes (which we explore in Chapter 23). S S S S Au surface Fig. 19.46 Self-assembled monolayers of alkylthiols formed on to a gold surface by reaction of the thiol groups with the surface and aggregation of the alkyl chains. Checklist of key ideas 1. A polymer is a compound formed by linking together small molecules. Many proteins (specifically protein enzymes) are monodisperse; a synthetic polymer is polydisperse. 2. The number-average molar mass, Jn, is the value obtained by weighting each molar mass by the number of molecules of that mass present in the sample; the weight-average molar mass, Jw, is the average calculated by weighting the molar masses of the molecules by the mass of each one present in the sample; the Z-average molar mass, JZ, is the average molar mass obtained from sedimentation measurements. 3. The heterogeneity index of a polymer sample is Jw/Jn. 4. Techniques for the determination of the mean molar masses of macromolecules include mass spectrometry (as MALDI), ultracentrifugation, laser light scattering, and viscometry. 5. The least structured model of a macromolecule is as a random coil; for a freely jointed random coil of contour length Nl, the root mean square separation is N1/2 l and the radius of gyration is Rg = (N/6)1/2 l. 6. The conformational entropy is the statistical entropy arising from the arrangement of bonds in a random coil. 7. The primary structure of a biopolymer is the sequence of its monomer units. 8. The secondary structure of a protein is the spatial arrangement of the polypeptide chain and includes the α-helix and β-sheet. 9. Helical and sheet-like polypeptide chains are folded into a tertiary structure by bonding influences between the residues of the chain. 10. Some macromolecules have a quaternary structure as aggregates of two or more polypeptide chains. 11. Synthetic polymers are classified as elastomers, fibres, and plastics. 12. A perfect elastomer is a polymer in which the internal energy is independent of the extension of the random coil; for small extensions a random coil model obeys a Hooke’s law restoring force. 13. Synthetic polymers undergo a transition from a state of high to low chain mobility at the glass transition temperature, Tg. 14. The melting temperature of a polymer is the temperature at which three-dimensional order is lost. 15. A mesophase is a bulk phase that is intermediate in character between a solid and a liquid. 16. A disperse system is a dispersion of small particles of one material in another. 17. Colloids are classified as lyophilic (solvent attracting, specifically hydrophilic for water) and lyophobic (solvent repelling, specifically hydrophobic). 18. A surfactant is a species that accumulates at the interface of two phases or substances and modifies the properties of the surface. FURTHER INFORMATION 691 19. The radius of shear is the radius of the sphere that captures the rigid layer of charge attached to a colloid particle. 20. The zeta potential is the electric potential at the radius of shear relative to its value in the distant, bulk medium. 21. The inner shell of charge and the outer atmosphere jointly constitute the electric double layer. 22. Many colloid particles are thermodynamically unstable but kinetically non-labile. 23. Flocculation is the reversible aggregation of colloidal particles; coagulation is the irreversible aggregation of colloidal particles. 24. The Schultze–Hardy rule states that hydrophobic colloids are flocculated most efficiently by ions of opposite charge type and high charge number. 25. A micelle is a colloid-sized cluster of molecules that forms at the critical micelle concentration (CMC) and at the Krafft temperature. 26. A liposome is a vesicle with an inward pointing inner surface of molecules surrounded by an outward pointing outer layer. 27. A lamellar micelle is an extended layer of molecules two molecules thick. 28. A monolayer, a single layer of molecules on a surface. A Langmuir–Blodgett film is a monolayer that has been transferred to a solid support. 29. Surface pressure is the difference between the surface tension of the pure solvent and the solution: π = γ * − γ. 30. The collapse pressure is the highest surface pressure sustained by a surface film. Further reading Articles and texts A.W. Adamson and A.P. Gast, Physical chemistry of surfaces. Wiley, New York (1997). J. Barker, Mass spectrometry. Wiley, New York (1999). C.E. Carraher, Jr., Seymour/Carraher’s polymer chemistry, Marcel Dekker (2000). D.F. Evans and H. Wennerström, The colloidal domain : where physics, chemistry, biology, and technology meet. Wiley-VCH, New York (1999). P. Flory, Principles of polymer chemistry. Cornell University Press, Ithaca (1953). C.S. Johnson and D.A. Gabriel, Laser light scattering. Dover, New York (1995). A.R. Leach, Molecular modelling: principles and applications. Longman, Harlow (1997). K.E. van Holde, W.C. Johnson, and P.S. Ho, Principles of physical biochemistry. Prentice Hall, Upper Saddle River (1998). P.C. Heimenz and R. Rajagopalan, Principles of colloid and surface chemistry. Marcel Dekker, New York (1997). Sources of data and information D.R. Lide (ed.), CRC Handbook of Chemistry and Physics, Sections 7 and 13. CRC Press, Boca Raton (2000). Further information Further information 19.1 The Rayleigh ratio Here we outline the key steps in the derivation of eqn 19.8 for the Rayleigh ratio. You are encouraged to consult sources in the Further reading section for additional details. The ratio of the intensity of the light scattered by a sample to the intensity of the incident light is (see Further reading): = (19.54) where r is the distance between the sample and the detector and φ is the angle of observation relative to the z-axis (φ = 90° in Fig. 19.3). It follows from eqn 19.7 that Rθ = π2 α2 ε2 rλ4 sin2 φ r2 π2 α2 ε2 rλ4 I I0 The relation between the polarizability and the refractive index, nr, of a solution is (see Appendix 3 for a qualitative explanation and Further reading for quantitative details) n2 r − n2 r,0 = (19.55) where nr,0 is the refractive index of the solvent and N is the number density of polymer molecules. Because N = cPNA/M (where cP is the mass concentration of the polymer and M is its molar mass), we have: α = (n2 r − n2 r,0) For a dilute solution, nr differs little from nr,0 and we can write: nr = nr,0 + cP + · · · D E F dnr dcP A B C εrM cPNA Nα εr 692 19 MATERIALS 1: MACROMOLECULES AND AGGREGATES It follows that n2 r ≈ n2 r,0 + 2nr,0 cP and therefore that α = (19.56) The Rayleigh ratio for scattering by a single molecule now becomes Rθ = 2 (19.57) For a sample of N molecules, we multiply the expression above by N = cPNAV/M and, after substituting Jw for M, obtain Rθ = KcPJw K = (19.58) Equation 19.8 follows after we multiply the right-hand side of this equation by the structure factor Pθ. Now we derive expressions for the structure factor. If the molecule is regarded as composed of a number of atoms i at distances Ri from a convenient point, interference occurs between the radiation scattered by each pair. The scattering from all the particles is then calculated by allowing for contributions from all possible orientations of each pair 4π2 n2 r,0V(dnr/dcP)2 λ4 NA D E F dnr dcP A B C 4π2 n2 r,0M2 λ4 N2 A D E F dnr dcP A B C 2εrnr,0M NA D E F dnr dcP A B C of atoms in each molecule. If there are N atoms in the macromolecule, and if all are assumed to have the same scattering power, then it is possible to show that (see Further reading) Pθ = ∑i,j , s = sin 1–2θ (19.59) where Rij is the separation of atoms i and j, and λ is the wavelength of the incident radiation. When the molecule is much smaller than the wavelength of the incident radiation in the sense that sRij << 1 (for example, if R = 5 nm, and λ = 500 nm, all the sRij are about 0.1), we can use the expansion sin x = x − 1 –6x3 + · · · to write sin sRij = sRij − 1 –6(sRij)3 + · · · and then Pθ = ∑i,j 1 − 1 –6(sRij)2 + · · · = 1 − ∑i,j R2 ij + · · · The sum over the squares of the separations gives the radius of gyration of the molecule (through eqn 19.32). Therefore Pθ ≈ 1 − 1 –3s2 R2 g = 1 − which is eqn 19.9. 16π2 R2 g sin2 1 –2θ 3λ2 s2 6N2 5 6 7 1 2 3 1 N2 4π λ sin sRij sRij 1 N2 Discussion questions 19.1 Distinguish between number-average, weight-average, and Z-average molar masses. Discuss experimental techniques that can measure each of these properties. 19.2 Suggest reasons why the techniques described in the preceding question produce different mass averages. 19.3 Distinguish between contour length, root mean square separation, and radius of gyration of a random coil. 19.4 Identify the terms in and limit the generality of the following expressions: (a) ∆S = −1 –2kN ln{(1 + ν)1+ν (1 − ν)1−ν }, (b) Rrms = (2N)1/2 l, and (c) Rg = (N/6)1/2 l. 19.5 Distinguish between molecular mechanics and molecular dynamics calculations. Why are these methods generally more popular in the field of polymer chemistry than the quantum mechanical procedures discussed in Chapter 11? 19.6 It is observed that the critical micelle concentration of sodium dodecyl sulfate in aqueous solution decreases as the concentration of added sodium chloride increases. Explain this effect. 19.7 Explain the physical origins of surface activity by surfactant molecules. 19.8 Discuss the physical origins of the surface Gibbs energy. 19.9 Self-assembled monolayers (SAMs) are receiving more attention than Langmuir–Blodgett (LB) films as starting points for nanofabrication. How do SAMs differ from LB films and why are SAMs more useful than LB films in nanofabrication work? Exercises 19.1a Calculate the number-average molar mass and the mass-average molar mass of a mixture of equal amounts of two polymers, one having M = 62 kg mol−1 and the other M = 78 kg mol−1 . 19.1b Calculate the number-average molar mass and the mass-average molar mass of a mixture of two polymers, one having M = 62 kg mol−1 and the other M = 78 kg mol−1 , with their amounts (numbers of moles) in the ratio 3:2. 19.2a The radius of gyration of a long chain molecule is found to be 7.3 nm. The chain consists of C-C links. Assume the chain is randomly coiled and estimate the number of links in the chain. 19.2b The radius of gyration of a long chain molecule is found to be 18.9 nm. The chain consists of links of length 450 pm. Assume the chain is randomly coiled and estimate the number of links in the chain. 19.3a A solution consists of solvent, 30 per cent by mass, of a dimer with M = 30 kg mol−1 and its monomer. What average molar mass would be obtained from measurement of (a) osmotic pressure, (b) light scattering? 19.3b A solution consists of 25 per cent by mass of a trimer with M = 22 kg mol−1 and its monomer. What average molar mass would be obtained from measurement of: (a) osmotic pressure, (b) light scattering? PROBLEMS 693 19.4a Evaluate the rotational correlation time, τR = 4πa3 η/3kT, for serum albumin in water at 25°C on the basis that it is a sphere of radius 3.0 nm. What is the value for a CCl4 molecule in carbon tetrachloride at 25°C? (Viscosity data in Table 21.4 in the Data section at the end of this volume; take a(CCl4) = 250 pm.) 19.4b Evaluate the rotational correlation time, τR = 4πa3 η/3kT, for a synthetic polymer in water at 20°C on the basis that it is a sphere of radius 4.5 nm. 19.5a What is the relative rate of sedimentation for two spherical particles of the same density, but which differ in radius by a factor of 10? 19.5b What is the relative rate of sedimentation for two spherical particles with densities 1.10 g cm−3 and 1.18 g cm−3 and which differ in radius by a factor of 8.4, the former being the larger? Use ρ = 0.794 g cm−3 for the density of the solution. 19.6a Human haemoglobin has a specific volume of 0.749 × 10−3 m3 kg−1 , a sedimentation constant of 4.48 Sv, and a diffusion coefficient of 6.9 × 10−11 m2 s−1 . Determine its molar mass from this information. 19.6b A synthetic polymer has a specific volume of 8.01 × 10−4 m3 kg−1 , a sedimentation constant of 7.46 Sv, and a diffusion coefficient of 7.72 × 10−11 m2 s−1 . Determine its molar mass from this information. 19.7a Find the drift speed of a particle of radius 20 µm and density 1750 kg m−3 which is settling from suspension in water (density 1000 kg m−3 ) under the influence of gravity alone. The viscosity of water is 8.9 × 10−4 kg m−1 s−1 . 19.7b Find the drift speed of a particle of radius 15.5 µm and density 1250 kg m−3 which is settling from suspension in water (density 1000 kg m−3 ) under the influence of gravity alone. The viscosity of water is 8.9 × 10−4 kg m−1 s−1 . 19.8a At 20°C the diffusion coefficient of a macromolecule is found to be 8.3 × 10−11 m2 s−1 . Its sedimentation constant is 3.2 Sv in a solution of density 1.06 g cm−3 . The specific volume of the macromolecule is 0.656 cm3 g−1 . Determine the molar mass of the macromolecule. 19.8b At 20°C the diffusion coefficient of a macromolecule is found to be 7.9 × 10−11 m2 s−1 . Its sedimentation constant is 5.1 Sv in a solution of density 997 kg m−3 . The specific volume of the macromolecule is 0.721 cm3 g−1 . Determine the molar mass of the macromolecule. 19.9a The data from a sedimentation equilibrium experiment performed at 300 K on a macromolecular solute in aqueous solution show that a graph of ln c against r2 is a straight line with a slope of 729 cm−2 . The rotational rate of the centrifuge was 50 000 r.p.m. The specific volume of the solute is 0.61 cm3 g−1 . Calculate the molar mass of the solute. 19.9b The data from a sedimentation equilibrium experiment performed at 293 K on a macromolecular solute in aqueous solution show that a graph of ln c against (r/cm)2 is a straight line with a slope of 821. The rotation rate of the centrifuge was 1080 Hz. The specific volume of the solute is 7.2 × 10−4 m3 kg−1 . Calculate the molar mass of the solute. 19.10a Calculate the radial acceleration (as so many g) in a cell placed at 6.0 cm from the centre of rotation in an ultracentrifuge operating at 80 000 r.p.m. 19.10b Calculate the radial acceleration (as so many g) in a cell placed at 5.50 cm from the centre of rotation in an ultracentrifuge operating at 1.32 kHz. 19.11a A polymer chain consists of 700 segments, each 0.90 nm long. If the chain were ideally flexible, what would be the r.m.s. separation of the ends of the chain? 19.11b A polymer chain consists of 1200 segments, each 1.125 nm long. If the chain were ideally flexible, what would be the r.m.s. separation of the ends of the chain? 19.12a Calculate the contour length (the length of the extended chain) and the root mean square separation (the end-to-end distance) for polyethylene with a molar mass of 280 kg mol−1 . 19.12b Calculate the contour length (the length of the extended chain) and the root mean square separation (the end-to-end distance) for polypropylene of molar mass 174 kg mol−1 . Problems* Numerical problems 19.1 In a sedimentation experiment the position of the boundary as a function of time was found to be as follows: t/min 15.5 29.1 36.4 58.2 r/cm 5.05 5.09 5.12 5.19 The rotation rate of the centrifuge was 45 000 r.p.m. Calculate the sedimentation constant of the solute. 19.2 Calculate the speed of operation (in r.p.m.) of an ultracentrifuge needed to obtain a readily measurable concentration gradient in a sedimentation equilibrium experiment. Take that gradient to be a concentration at the bottom of the cell about five times greater than at the top. Use rtop = 5.0 cm, rbott = 7.0 cm, M ≈ 105 g mol−1 , ρvs ≈ 0.75, T = 298 K. 19.3 The concentration dependence of the viscosity of a polymer solution is found to be as follows: c/(g dm−3 ) 1.32 2.89 5.73 9.17 η/(g m−1 s−1 ) 1.08 1.20 1.42 1.73 The viscosity of the solvent is 0.985 g m−1 s−1 . What is the intrinsic viscosity of the polymer? 19.4 The times of flow of dilute solutions of polystyrene in benzene through a viscometer at 25°C are given in the table below. From these data, calculate the molar mass of the polystyrene samples. Since the solutions are dilute, assume that the densities of the solutions are the same as those of pure benzene. η(benzene) = 0.601 × 10−3 kg m−1 s−1 (0.601 cP) at 25°C. c/(g dm−3 ) 0 2.22 5.00 8.00 10.00 t/s 208.2 248.1 303.4 371.8 421.3 19.5 The viscosities of solutions of polyisobutylene in benzene were measured at 24°C (the θ temperature for the system) with the following results: c/(g/102 cm3 ) 0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 η/(10−3 kg m−1 s−1 ) 0.647 0.690 0.733 0.777 0.821 0.865 Use the information in Table 19.4 to deduce the molar mass of the polymer. 19.6‡ Polystyrene in cyclohexane at 34.5°C forms a θ solution, with an intrinsic viscosity related to the molar mass by [η] = KMa . The following data * Problems denoted with the symbol ‡ were supplied by Charles Trapp and Carmen Giunta. 694 19 MATERIALS 1: MACROMOLECULES AND AGGREGATES on polystyrene in cyclohexane are taken from L.J. Fetters, N. Hadjichristidis, J.S. Lindner, and J.W. Mays (J. Phys. Chem. Ref. Data 23, 619 (1994)): M/(kg mol−1 ) 10.0 19.8 106 249 359 860 1800 5470 9720 56 800 [η]/(cm3 g−1 ) 8.90 11.9 28.1 44.0 51.2 77.6 113.9 195 275 667 Determine the parameters K and a. What is the molar mass of a polystyrene that forms a θ solution in cyclohexane with [η] = 100 cm3 g−1 ? 19.7‡ Standard polystyrene solutions of known average molar masses continue to be used as for the calibration of many methods of characterizing polymer solutions. M. Kolinsky and J. Janca (J. Polym. Sci., Polym. Chem. 12, 1181 (1974)) studied polystyrene in tetrahydrofuran (THF) for use in calibrating a gel permeation chromatograph. Their results for the intrinsic viscosity, [η], as a function of average molar mass at 25°C are given in the table below. (a) Obtain the Mark–Houwink constants that fit these data. (b) Compare your values to those in Table 19.4 and Example 19.5. How might you explain the differences? Jv/(kg mol−1 ) 5.0 10.3 19.85 51 98.2 173 411 867 [η]/(cm3 g−1 ) 5.2 8.8 14.0 27.6 43.6 67.0 125.0 206.7 19.8 The concentration dependence of the osmotic pressure of solutions of a macromolecule at 20°C was found to be as follows: c/(g dm−3 ) 1.21 2.72 5.08 6.60 Π/Pa 134 321 655 898 Determine the molar mass of the macromolecule and the osmotic virial coefficient. 19.9 The osmotic pressure of a fraction of poly(vinyl chloride) in a ketone solvent was measured at 25°C. The density of the solvent (which is virtually equal to the density of the solution) was 0.798 g cm−3 . Calculate the molar mass and the osmotic virial coefficient, B, of the fraction from the following data: c/(g /102 cm3 ) 0.200 0.400 0.600 0.088 1.000 h/cm 0.48 1.2 1.86 2.76 3.88 19.10 The following table lists the glass transition temperatures, Tg, of several polymers. Discuss the reasons why the structure of the monomer unit has an effect on the value of Tg. Polymer Poly(oxymethylene) Polyethylene Poly(vinyl chloride) Polystyrene Structure -(OCH2)n- -(CH2CH2)n- -(CH2–CHCl)n- -(CH2-CH(C6H5))nTg/K 198 253 354 381 Theoretical problems 19.11 In formamide as solvent, poly(γ-benzyl-L-glutamate) is found by light scattering experiments to have a radius of gyration proportional to M; in contrast, polystyrene in butanone has Rg proportional to M1/2 . Present arguments to show that the first polymer is a rigid rod whereas the second is a random coil. 19.12 The kinematic viscosity, ν, of a fluid is defined as η/ρ, where ρ is the mass density. What are the SI units of kinematic viscosity? Confirm that the drainage times through a narrow tube are governed by the kinematic viscosity by referring to the Poiseuille equation for fluid flow (eqn 21.25) and hence confirm eqn 19.24. 19.13 A polymerization process produced a Gaussian distribution of polymers in the sense that the proportion of molecules having a molar mass in the range M to M + dM was proportional to e−(M−J)2 /2γ dM. What is the number average molar mass when the distribution is narrow? 19.14 Show how eqn 19.26 for a one-dimensional freely jointed chain can be used to derive eqn 19.27 for a three-dimensional freely-jointed chain. Hint. Write the probability that the ends lie in the range nx to nx + dnx as dPx = Pdnx, with P given in eqn 19.26, and similarly for the other two dimensions. Multiply these probabilities together, and integrate dnxdnydnz over a shell of thickness dn. Don’t count negative integers (that is, divide the volume of the shell by 8, corresponding to the all-positive octant of values). 19.15 Use eqn 19.27 to deduce expressions for (a) the root mean square separation of the ends of the chain, (b) the mean separation of the ends, and (c) their most probable separation. Evaluate these three quantities for a fully flexible chain with N = 4000 and l = 154 pm. 19.16 Construct a two-dimensional random walk by using a random number generating routine with mathematical software or electronic spreadsheet. Construct a walk of 50 and 100 steps. If there are many people working on the problem, investigate the mean and most probable separations in the plots by direct measurement. Do they vary as N1/2 ? 19.17 Evaluate the radius of gyration, Rg, of (a) a solid sphere of radius a, (b) a long straight rod of radius a and length l. Show that in the case of a solid sphere of specific volume vs, Rg/nm ≈ 0.056902 × {(vs/cm3 g−1 )(M/g mol−1 )}1/3 . Evaluate Rg for a species with M = 100 kg mol−1 , vs = 0.750 cm3 g−1 , and, in the case of the rod, of radius 0.50 nm. 19.18 The effective radius, a, of a random coil is related to its radius of gyration, Rg, by a = γRg, with γ = 0.85. Deduce an expression for the osmotic virial coefficient, B, in terms of the number of chain units for (a) a freely jointed chain, (b) a chain with tetrahedral bond angles. Evaluate B for l = 154 pm and N = 4000. Estimate B for a randomly coiled polyethylene chain of arbitrary molar mass, M, and evaluate it for M = 56 kg mol−1 . Use B = 1 –2NAvP, where vP is the excluded volume due to a single molecule. 19.19 Radius of gyration is defined in eqn 19.32. Show that an equivalent definition is that Rg is the average root mean square distance of the atoms or groups (all assumed to be of the same mass), that is, that R2 g = (1/N)∑jRj 2 , where Rj is the distance of atom j from the centre of mass. 19.20 Consider the thermodynamic description of stretching rubber. The observables are the tension, t, and length, l (the analogues of p and V for gases). Because dw = tdl, the basic equation is dU = TdS + tdl. (The term pdV is supposed negligible throughout.) If G = U − TS − tl, find expressions for dG and dA, and deduce the Maxwell relations T = − l T = − t Go on to deduce the equation of state for rubber, T = t − l 19.21 On the assumption that the tension required to keep a sample at a constant length is proportional to the temperature (t = aT, the analogue of p ∝ T), show that the tension can be ascribed to the dependence of the entropy on the length of the sample. Account for this result in terms of the molecular nature of the sample. Applications: to biochemistry and technology 19.22 In this problem you will use molecular mechanics software of your instructor’s choice to gain some appreciation for the complexity of the calculations that lead to plots such as those in Fig. 19.29. Our model for the protein is the dipeptide (15) in which the terminal methyl groups replace the rest of the polypeptide chain. (a) Draw three initial conformers of the dipeptide with R = H: one with φ = +75°, ψ = −65°, a second with φ = ψ = +180°, and a third with φ = +65°, ψ = +35°. Use a molecular mechanics routine to optimize the geometry of each conformer and measure the total potential energy and the final φ and ψ angles in each case. (Although any force field will work satisfactorily, the AMBER force field is strongly recommended, as it is optimized for calculations on biopolymers.) Did all of the initial conformers converge to the same final conformation? If not, what do these D E F ∂t ∂T A B C D E F ∂U ∂l A B C D E F ∂l ∂T A B C D E F ∂S ∂t A B C D E F ∂t ∂T A B C D E F ∂S ∂l A B C PROBLEMS 695 final conformers represent? Rationalize any observed differences in total potential energy of the final conformers. (b) Use the approach in part (a) to investigate the case R = CH3, with the same three initial conformers as starting points for the calculations. Rationalize any similarities and differences between the final conformers of the dipeptides with R = H and R = CH3. 19.23 Calculate the excluded volume in terms of the molecular volume on the basis that the molecules are spheres of radius a. Evaluate the osmotic virial coefficient in the case of bushy stunt virus, a = 14.0 nm, and haemoglobin, a = 3.2 nm (see Problem 19.18). Evaluate the percentage deviation of the Rayleigh ratios of 1.00 g/(100 cm3 ) solutions of bushy stunt virus (M = 1.07 × 104 kg mol−1 ) and haemoglobin (M = 66.5 kg mol−1 ) from the ideal solution values. In eqn 19.8, let Pθ = 1 and assume that both solutions have the same K value. 19.24 Use the information below and the expression for Rg of a solid sphere quoted in the Problem 19.17, to classify the species below as globular or rod-like. M/(g mol−1 ) vs/(cm3 g−1 ) Rg/nm Serum albumin 66 × 103 0.752 2.98 Bushy stunt virus 10.6 × 106 0.741 12.0 DNA 4 × 106 0.556 117.0 19.25 Suppose that a rod-like DNA molecule of length 250 nm undergoes a conformational change to a closed-circular (cc) form. (a) Use the information in Problem 19.24 and an incident wavelength λ = 488 nm to calculate the ratio of scattering intensities by each of these conformations, Irod/Icc, when θ = 20°, 45°, and 90°. (b) Suppose that you wish to use light scattering as a technique for the study of conformational changes in DNA molecules. Based on your answer to part (a), at which angle would you conduct the experiments? Justify your choice. 19.26 In an ultracentrifugation experiment at 20°C on bovine serum albumin the following data were obtained: ρ = 1.001 g cm−3 , vs = 1.112 cm3 g−1 , ω/2π = 322 Hz, r/cm 5.0 5.1 5.2 5.3 5.4 c/(mg cm−3 ) 0.536 0.284 0.148 0.077 0.039 Evaluate the molar mass of the sample. 19.27 Sedimentation studies on haemoglobin in water gave a sedimentation constant S = 4.5 Sv at 20°C. The diffusion coefficient is 6.3 × 10−11 m2 s−1 at the same temperature. Calculate the molar mass of haemoglobin using vs = 0.75 cm3 g−1 for its partial specific volume and ρ = 0.998 g cm−3 for the density of the solution. Estimate the effective radius of the haemoglobin molecule given that the viscosity of the solution is 1.00 × 10−3 kg m−1 s−1 . 19.28 The rate of sedimentation of a recently isolated protein was monitored at 20°C and with a rotor speed of 50 000 r.p.m. The boundary receded as follows: t/s 0 300 600 900 1200 1500 1800 r/cm 6.127 6.153 6.179 6.206 6.232 6.258 6.284 Calculate the sedimentation constant and the molar mass of the protein on the basis that its partial specific volume is 0.728 cm3 g−1 and its diffusion coefficient is 7.62 × 10−11 m2 s−1 at 20°C, the density of the solution then being 0.9981 g cm−3 . Suggest a shape for the protein given that the viscosity of the solution is 1.00 × 10−3 kg m−1 s−1 at 20°C. 19.29 For some proteins, the isoelectric point must be obtained by extrapolation because the macromolecule might not be stable over a very wide pH range. Estimate the pH of the isoelectric point from the following data for a protein: pH 4.5 5.0 5.5 6.0 Drift speed/(µm s−1 ) −0.10 −0.20 −0.30 −0.35 19.30 Here we use concepts developed in Chapter 16 and this chapter to enhance our understanding of closed-circular and supercoiled DNA. (a) The average end-to-end distance of a flexible polymer (such as a fully denatured polypeptide or a strand of DNA) is N1/2 l, where N is the number of groups (residues or bases) and l is the length of each group. Initially, therefore, one end of the polymer can be found anywhere within a sphere of radius N1/2 l centred on the other end. When the ends join to form a circle, they are confined to a volume or radius l. What is the change in molar entropy? Plot the function you derive as a function of N. (b) The energy necessary to twist ccDNA by i turns is εi = ki2 , with k an empirical constant and i being negative or positive depending on the sense of the twist. For example, one twist (i = ±1) makes ccDNA resemble the number 8. (i) Show that the distribution of the populations pi = ni/N of ccDNA molecules with i turns at a specified temperature has the form of a Gaussian function. (ii) Plot the expression you derived in part (a) for several values of the temperature. Does the curve has a maximum? If so, at what value of i? Comment on variations of the shape of the curve with temperature. (iii) Calculate p0, p1, p5, and p10 at 298 K. 19.31 The melting temperature of a DNA molecule can be determined by differential scanning calorimetry (Impact I2.1). The following data were obtained in aqueous solutions containing the specified concentration csalt of an soluble ionic solid for a series of DNA molecules with varying base pair composition, with f the fraction of G-C base pairs: csalt = 1.0 × 10−2 mol dm−3 f 0.375 0.509 0.589 0.688 0.750 Tm/K 339 344 348 351 354 csalt = 0.15 mol dm−3 f 0.375 0.509 0.589 0.688 0.750 Tm/K 359 364 368 371 374 (a) Estimate the melting temperature of a DNA molecule containing 40.0 per cent G-C base pairs in both samples. Hint. Begin by plotting Tm against fraction of G-C base pairs and examining the shape of the curve. (b) Do the data show an effect of concentration of ions in solution on the melting temperature of DNA? If so, provide a molecular interpretation for the effect you observe. 19.32 The fluidity of a lipid bilayer dispersed in aqueous solution depends on temperature and there are two important melting transitions. One transition is from a ‘solid crystalline’ state in which the hydrophobic chains are packed together tightly (hence move very little) to a ‘liquid crystalline state’, in which there is increased but still limited movement of the of the chains. The second transition, which occurs at a higher temperature than the first, is from the liquid crystalline state to a liquid state, in which the hydrophobic interactions holding the aggregate together are largely disrupted. (a) It is observed that the transition temperatures increase with the hydrophobic chain length and decrease with the number of C=C bonds in the chain. Explain these observations. (b) What effect is the inclusion of cholesterol likely to have on the transition temperatures of a lipid bilayer? Justify your answer. 19.33 Polystyrene is a synthetic polymer with the structure -(CH2CH(C6H5))n-. A batch of polydisperse polystyrene was prepared by initiating the polymerization with t-butyl radicals. As a result, the t-butyl group is 696 19 MATERIALS 1: MACROMOLECULES AND AGGREGATES expected to be covalently attached to the end of the final products. A sample from this batch was embedded in an organic matrix containing silver trifluoroacetate and the resulting MALDI-TOF spectrum consisted of a large number of peaks separated by 104 g mol−1 , with the most intense peak at 25 578 g mol−1 . Comment on the purity of this sample and determine the number of (CH2-CH(C6H5)) units in the species that gives rise to the most intense peak in the spectrum . 19.34 A manufacturer of polystyrene beads claims that they have an average molar mass of 250 kg mol−1 . Solutions of these beads are studied by a physical chemistry student by dilute solution viscometry with an Ostwald viscometer in both the ‘good’ solvent toluene and the theta solvent cyclohexane. The drainage times, tD, as a function of concentration for the two solvents are given in the table below. (a) Fit the data to the virial equation for viscosity, η = η*(1 + [η]c + k′[η]2 c2 + · · · ) where k′ is called the Huggins constant and is typically in the range 0.35–0.40. From the fit, determine the intrinsic viscosity and the Huggins constant. (b) Use the empirical Mark–Kuhn–Houwink–Sakurada equation (eqn 19.25) to determine the molar mass of polystyrene in the two solvents. For theta solvents, a = 0.5 and K = 8.2 × 10−5 dm3 g−1 for cyclohexane; for the good solvent toluene a = 0.72 and K = 1.15 × 10−5 dm3 g−1 . (c) According to a general theory proposed by Kirkwood and Riseman, the root mean square end-to-end distance of a polymer chain in solution is related to [η] by [η] = Φ͗r2 ͘3/2 /M, where Φ is a universal constant with the value 2.84 × 1026 when [η] is expressed in cubic decimetres per gram and the distance is in metres. Calculate this quantity for each solvent. (d) From the molar masses calculate the average number of styrene (C6H5CH=CH2) monomer units, ͗n͘, (e) Calculate the length of a fully stretched, planar zigzag configuration, taking the C-C distance as 154 pm and the CCC bond angle to be 109°. (f) Use eqn 19.33 to calculate the radius of gyration, Rg. Also calculate ͗r2 ͘1/2 = n1/2 . Compare this result with that predicted by the Kirkwood–Riseman theory: which gives the better fit? (g) Compare your values for M to the results of Problem 19.33. Is there any reason why they should or should not agree? Is the manufacturer’s claim valid? c/(g dm−3 toluene) 0 1.0 3.0 5.0 tD/s 8.37 9.11 10.72 12.52 c/(g dm−3 cyclohexane) 0 1.0 1.5 2.0 tD/s 8.32 8.67 8.85 9.03 19.35‡ The determination of the average molar masses of conducting polymers is an important part of their characterization. S. Holdcroft (J. Polym. Sci., Polym. Phys. 29, 1585 (1991)) has determined the molar mases and Mark–Houwink constants for the electronically conducting polymer, poly(3-hexylthiophene) (P3HT) in tetrahydrofuran (THF) at 25°C by methods similar to those used for nonconducting polymers. The values for molar mass and intrinsic viscosity in the table below are adapted from their data. Determine the constants in the Mark–Kuhn–Houwink–Sakurada equation from these results and compare to the values obtained in your solution to Problem 19.7 . Jv /(kg mol−1 ) 3.8 11.1 15.3 58.8 [η]/(cm3 g−1 ) 6.23 17.44 23.73 85.28 Materials 2: the solid state First, we see how to describe the regular arrangement of atoms in crystals and the symmetry of their arrangement. Then we consider the basic principles of X-ray diffraction and see how the diffraction pattern can be interpreted in terms of the distribution of electron density in a unit cell. X-ray diffraction leads to information about the structures of metallic, ionic, and molecular solids, and we review some typical results and their rationalization in terms of atomic and ionic radii. With structures established, we move on to the properties of solids, and see how their mechanical, electrical, optical, and magnetic properties stem from the properties of their constituent atoms and molecules. The solid state includes most of the materials that make modern technology possible. It includes the wide varieties of steel that are used in architecture and engineering, the semiconductors and metallic conductors that are used in information technology and power distribution, the ceramics that increasingly are replacing metals, and the synthetic and natural polymers that are used in the textile industry and in the fabrication of many of the common objects of the modern world. The properties of solids stem, of course, from the arrangement and properties of the constituent atoms, and one of the challenges of this chapter is to see how a wide range of bulk properties, including rigidity, electrical conductivity, and optical and magnetic properties stem from the properties of atoms. One crucial aspect of this link is the pattern in which the atoms (and molecules) are stacked together, and we start this chapter with an examination of how the structures of solids are described and determined. Crystal lattices Early in the history of modern science it was suggested that the regular external form of crystals implied an internal regularity of their constituents. In this section we see how to describe the arrangement of atoms inside crystals. 20.1 Lattices and unit cells A crystal is built up from regularly repeating ‘structural motifs’, which may be atoms, molecules, or groups of atoms, molecules, or ions. A space lattice is the pattern formed by points representing the locations of these motifs (Fig. 20.1). The space lattice is, in effect, an abstract scaffolding for the crystal structure. More formally, a space lattice is a three-dimensional, infinite array of points, each of which is surrounded in an identical way by its neighbours, and which defines the basic structure of the crystal. In some cases there may be a structural motif centred on each lattice 20 Crystal lattices 20.1 Lattices and unit cells 20.2 The identification of lattice planes 20.3 The investigation of structure I20.1 Impact on biochemistry: X-ray crystallography of biological macromolecules 20.4 Neutron and electron diffraction Crystal structure 20.5 Metallic solids 20.6 Ionic solids 20.7 Molecular solids and covalent networks The properties of solids 20.8 Mechanical properties 20.9 Electrical properties I20.2 Impact on nanoscience: Nanowires 20.10 Optical properties 20.11 Magnetic properties 20.12 Superconductors Checklist of key ideas Further reading Discussion questions Exercises Problems 698 20 MATERIALS 2: THE SOLID STATE Fig. 20.1 Each lattice point specifies the location of a structural motif (for example, a molecule or a group of molecules). The crystal lattice is the array of lattice points; the crystal structure is the collection of structural motifs arranged according to the lattice. Comment 20.1 A symmetry operation is an action (such as a rotation, reflection, or inversion) that leaves an object looking the same after it has been carried out. There is a corresponding symmetry element for each symmetry operation, which is the point, line, or plane with respect to which the symmetry operation is performed. For instance, an n-fold rotation (the symmetry operation) about an n-fold axis of symmetry (the corresponding symmetry element) is a rotation through 360°/n. See Chapter 12 for a more detailed discussion of symmetry. Fig. 20.2 A unit cell is a parallel-sided (but not necessarily rectangular) figure from which the entire crystal structure can be constructed by using only translations (not reflections, rotations, or inversions). Fig. 20.3 A unit cell can be chosen in a variety of ways, as shown here. It is conventional to choose the cell that represents the full symmetry of the lattice. In this rectangular lattice, the rectangular unit cell would normally be adopted. C3 Fig. 20.4 The notation for the sides and angles of a unit cell. Note that the angle α lies in the plane (b,c) and perpendicular to the axis a. Fig. 20.5 A unit cell belonging to the cubic system has four threefold axes, denoted C3, arranged tetrahedrally. The insert shows the threefold symmetry. point, but that is not necessary. The crystal structure itself is obtained by associating with each lattice point an identical structural motif. The unit cell is an imaginary parallelepiped (parallel-sided figure) that contains one unit of the translationally repeating pattern (Fig. 20.2). A unit cell can be thought of as the fundamental region from which the entire crystal may be constructed by purely translational displacements (like bricks in a wall). A unit cell is commonly formed by joining neighbouring lattice points by straight lines (Fig. 20.3). Such unit cells are called primitive. It is sometimes more convenient to draw larger nonprimitive unit cells that also have lattice points at their centres or on pairs of opposite faces. An infinite number of different unit cells can describe the same lattice, but the one with sides that have the shortest lengths and that are most nearly perpendicular to one another is normally chosen. The lengths of the sides of a unit cell are denoted a, b, and c, and the angles between them are denoted α, β, and γ (Fig. 20.4). Unit cells are classified into seven crystal systems by noting the rotational symmetry elements they possess. A cubic unit cell, for example, has four threefold axes in a tetrahedral array (Fig. 20.5). A monoclinic unit cell has one twofold axis; the unique 20.1 LATTICES AND UNIT CELLS 699 C2 Fig. 20.6 A unit belonging to the monoclinic system has a twofold axis (denoted C2 and shown in more detail in the insert). Fig. 20.7 A triclinic unit cell has no axes of rotational symmetry. Fig. 20.8 The fourteen Bravais lattices. The points are lattice points, and are not necessarily occupied by atoms. P denotes a primitive unit cell (R is used for a trigonal lattice), I a bodycentred unit cell, F a face-centred unit cell, and C (or A or B) a cell with lattice points on two opposite faces. Table 20.1 The seven crystal systems System Essential symmetries Triclinic None Monoclinic One C2 axis Orthorhombic Three perpendicular C2 axes Rhombohedral One C3 axis Tetragonal One C4 axis Hexagonal One C6 axis Cubic Four C3 axes in a tetrahedral arrangement Cubic P Cubic I Cubic F Tetragonal P Tetragonal I Orthorhombic P Orthorhombic C Orthorhombic I Orthorhombic F Monoclinic P Monoclinic C Triclinic Hexagonal Trigonal R a a a a a c a b c a a a b b c c g b b a a a a ac 120° axis is by convention the b axis (Fig. 20.6). A triclinic unit cell has no rotational symmetry, and typically all three sides and angles are different (Fig. 20.7). Table 20.1 lists the essential symmetries, the elements that must be present for the unit cell to belong to a particular crystal system. There are only 14 distinct space lattices in three dimensions. These Bravais lattices are illustrated in Fig. 20.8. It is conventional to portray these lattices by primitive unit cells in some cases and by non-primitive unit cells in others. A primitive unit cell (with lattice points only at the corners) is denoted P. A body-centred unit cell (I) also has a lattice point at its centre. A face-centred unit cell (F) has lattice points at its corners and also at the centres of its six faces. A side-centred unit cell (A, B, or C) has lattice points at its corners and at the centres of two opposite faces. For simple structures, it is often convenient to choose an atom belonging to the structural motif, or the 700 20 MATERIALS 2: THE SOLID STATE 20.9 Some of the planes that can be drawn through the points of a rectangular space lattice and their corresponding Miller indices (hkl): (a) (110), (b) (230), (c) (⁄10), and (d) (010). centre of a molecule, as the location of a lattice point or the vertex of a unit cell, but that is not a necessary requirement. 20.2 The identification of lattice planes The spacing of the planes of lattice points in a crystal is an important quantitative aspect of its structure. However, there are many different sets of planes (Fig. 20.9), and we need to be able to label them. Two-dimensional lattices are easier to visualize than three-dimensional lattices, so we shall introduce the concepts involved by referring to two dimensions initially, and then extend the conclusions by analogy to three dimensions. (a) The Miller indices Consider a two-dimensional rectangular lattice formed from a unit cell of sides a, b (as in Fig. 20.9). Each plane in the illustration (except the plane passing through the origin) can be distinguished by the distances at which it intersects the a and b axes. One way to label each set of parallel planes would therefore be to quote the smallest intersection distances. For example, we could denote the four sets in the illustration as (1a,1b), (1 –2a,1 –3b), (−1a,1b), and (∞a,1b). However, if we agree to quote distances along the axes as multiples of the lengths of the unit cell, then we can label the planes more simply as (1,1), (1 –2,1 –3), (−1,1), and (∞,1). If the lattice in Fig. 20.9 is the top view of a three-dimensional orthorhombic lattice in which the unit cell has a length c in the zdirection, all four sets of planes intersect the z-axis at infinity. Therefore, the full labels are (1,1,∞), (1 –2,1 –3,∞), (−1,1,∞), and (∞,1,∞). The presence of fractions and infinity in the labels is inconvenient. They can be eliminated by taking the reciprocals of the labels. As we shall see, taking reciprocals turns out to have further advantages. The Miller indices, (hkl), are the reciprocals of intersection distances (with fractions cleared by multiplying through by an appropriate factor, if taking the reciprocal results in a fraction). For example, the (1,1,∞) planes in Fig. 20.9a are the (110) planes in the Miller notation. Similarly, the (1 –2,1 –3,∞) planes are denoted (230). Negative indices are written with a bar over the number, and Fig. 20.9c shows the (⁄10) planes. The Miller indices for the four sets of planes in Fig. 20.9 are therefore (110), (230), (⁄10), and (010). Figure 20.10 shows a threedimensional representation of a selection of planes, including one in a lattice with non-orthogonal axes. The notation (hkl) denotes an individual plane. To specify a set of parallel planes we use the notation {hkl}. Thus, we speak of the (110) plane in a lattice, and the set of all {110} planes that lie parallel to the (110) plane. A helpful feature to remember is that, the smaller the absolute value of h in {hkl}, the more nearly parallel the set of planes is to the a axis (the {h00} planes are an exception). The same is true of k and the b axis and l and the c axis. When h = 0, the planes intersect the a axis at infinity, so the {0kl} a b c (110) (111) (100) (111) b c a Fig. 20.10 Some representative planes in three dimensions and their Miller indices. Note that a 0 indicates that a plane is parallel to the corresponding axis, and that the indexing may also be used for unit cells with non-orthogonal axes. Fig. 20.9 Some of the planes that can be drawn through the points of a rectangular space lattice and their corresponding Miller indices (hkl): (a) (110), (b) (230), (c) (⁄10), and (d) (010). (a) (b) (c) (d) 20.2 THE IDENTIFICATION OF LATTICE PLANES 701 a a a/k a/h ( )hkl dhkl Fig. 20.11 The dimensions of a unit cell and their relation to the plane passing through the lattice points. {110} {220} Fig. 20.12 The separation of the {220} planes is half that of the {110} planes. In general, (the separation of the planes {nh,nk,nl} is n times smaller than the separation of the {hkl} planes. planes are parallel to the a axis. Similarly, the {h0l} planes are parallel to b and the {hk0} planes are parallel to c. (b) The separation of planes The Miller indices are very useful for expressing the separation of planes. The separation of the {hk0} planes in the square lattice shown in Fig. 20.11 is given by = or dhk0 = (20.1) By extension to three dimensions, the separation of the {hkl} planes of a cubic lattice is given by = or dhkl = (20.2) The corresponding expression for a general orthorhombic lattice is the generalization of this expression: = + + (20.3) Example 20.1 Using the Miller indices Calculate the separation of (a) the {123} planes and (b) the {246} planes of an orthorhombic unit cell with a = 0.82 nm, b = 0.94 nm, and c = 0.75 nm. Method For the first part, simply substitute the information into eqn 20.3. For the second part, instead of repeating the calculation, note that if all three Miller indices are multiplied by n, then their separation is reduced by that factor (Fig. 20.12): = + + = n2 + + = which implies that dnh,nk,nl = Answer Substituting the indices into eqn 20.3 gives = + + = 0.22 nm−2 Hence, d123 = 0.21 nm. It then follows immediately that d246 is one-half this value, or 0.11 nm. A note on good practice It is always sensible to look for analytical relations between quantities rather than to evaluate expressions numerically each time for that emphasizes the relations between quantities (and avoids unnecessary work). Self-test 20.1 Calculate the separation of (a) the {133} planes and (b) the {399} planes in the same lattice. [0.19 nm, 0.063 nm] 32 (0.75 nm)2 22 (0.94 nm)2 12 (0.82 nm)2 1 d2 123 dhkl n n2 d2 hkl D F l2 c2 k2 b2 h2 a2 A C (nl)2 c2 (nk)2 b2 (nh)2 a2 1 d2 nh,nk,nl l2 c2 k2 b2 h2 a2 1 d2 hkl a (h2 + k2 + l2 )1/2 h2 + k2 + l2 a2 1 d2 hkl a (h2 + k2 )1/2 h2 + k2 a2 1 d2 hk0 702 20 MATERIALS 2: THE SOLID STATE 20.3 The investigation of structure Acharacteristicpropertyofwavesisthattheyinterferewithoneanother,givingagreater displacement where peaks or troughs coincide and a smaller displacement where peaks coincide with troughs (Fig. 20.13). According to classical electromagnetic theory, the intensity of electromagnetic radiation is proportional to the square of the amplitude of the waves. Therefore, the regions of constructive or destructive interference show up as regions of enhanced or diminished intensities. The phenomenon of diffraction is the interference caused by an object in the path of waves, and the pattern of varying intensity that results is called the diffraction pattern. Diffraction occurs when the dimensions of the diffracting object are comparable to the wavelength of the radiation. (a) X-ray diffraction Wilhelm Röntgen discovered X-rays in 1895. Seventeen years later, Max von Laue suggested that they might be diffracted when passed through a crystal, for by then he had realized that their wavelengths are comparable to the separation of lattice planes. This suggestion was confirmed almost immediately by Walter Friedrich and Paul Knipping and has grown since then into a technique of extraordinary power. The bulk of this section will deal with the determination of structures using X-ray diffraction. The mathematical procedures necessary for the determination of structure from Xray diffraction data are enormously complex, but such is the degree of integration of computers into the experimental apparatus that the technique is almost fully automated, even for large molecules and complex solids. The analysis is aided by molecular modelling techniques, which can guide the investigation towards a plausible structure. X-rays are electromagnetic radiation with wavelengths of the order of 10−10 m. They are typically generated by bombarding a metal with high-energy electrons (Fig. 20.14). The electrons decelerate as they plunge into the metal and generate radiation with a continuous range of wavelengths called Bremsstrahlung.1 Superimposed on the (a) (b) Fig. 20.13 When two waves are in the same region of space they interfere. Depending on their relative phase, they may interfere (a) constructively, to give an enhanced amplitude, or (b) destructively, to give a smaller amplitude. The component waves are shown in green and blue and the resultant in purple. Cooling water X-rays Beryllium window Electronbeam Metal target Fig. 20.14 X-rays are generated by directing an electron beam on to a cooled metal target. Beryllium is transparent to X-rays (on account of the small number of electrons in each atom) and is used for the windows. 1 Bremse is German for deceleration, Strahlung for ray. 20.3 THE INVESTIGATION OF STRUCTURE 703 K K Wavelength Intensity Bremsstrahlung b a K L Ionization X-ray Electron beam Ejected electron Energy Fig. 20.15 The X-ray emission from a metal consists of a broad, featureless Bremsstrahlung background, with sharp transitions superimposed on it. The label K indicates that the radiation comes from a transition in which an electron falls into a vacancy in the K shell of the atom. Fig. 20.16 The processes that contribute to the generation of X-rays. An incoming electron collides with an electron (in the K shell), and ejects it. Another electron (from the L shell in this illustration) falls into the vacancy and emits its excess energy as an X-ray photon. 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 Glancing angle, 2 Intensity (a) NaCl (b) KCl q Fig. 20.17 X-ray powder photographs of (a) NaCl, (b) KCl and the indexed reflections. The smaller number of lines in (b) is a consequence of the similarity of the K+ and Cl− scattering factors, as discussed later in the chapter. continuum are a few high-intensity, sharp peaks (Fig. 20.15). These peaks arise from collisions of the incoming electrons with the electrons in the inner shells of the atoms. A collision expels an electron from an inner shell, and an electron of higher energy drops into the vacancy, emitting the excess energy as an X-ray photon (Fig. 20.16). If the electron falls into a K shell (a shell with n = 1), the X-rays are classified as Kradiation, and similarly for transitions into the L (n = 2) and M (n = 3) shells. Strong, distinct lines are labelled Kα, Kβ, and so on. Increasingly, X-ray diffraction makes use of the radiation available from synchrotron sources (Further information 13.1), for its high intensity greatly enhances the sensitivity of the technique. von Laue’s original method consisted of passing a broad-band beam of X-rays into a single crystal, and recording the diffraction pattern photographically. The idea behind the approach was that a crystal might not be suitably orientated to act as a diffraction grating for a single wavelength but, whatever its orientation, diffraction would be achieved for at least one of the wavelengths if a range of wavelengths was used. There is currently a resurgence of interest in this approach because synchrotron radiation spans a range of X-ray wavelengths. An alternative technique was developed by Peter Debye and Paul Scherrer and independently by Albert Hull. They used monochromatic radiation and a powdered sample. When the sample is a powder, at least some of the crystallites will be orientated so as to give rise to diffraction. In modern powder diffractometers the intensities of the reflections are monitored electronically as the detector is rotated around the sample in a plane containing the incident ray (Fig. 20.17). Powder diffraction techniques are used to identify a sample of a solid substance by comparison of the positions of the diffraction lines and their intensities with diffraction patterns stored in a large data bank. Powder diffraction data are also used to determine phase diagrams, for different solid phases result in different diffraction patterns, and to determine the relative amounts of each phase present in a mixture. The technique is also used for the initial determination of the dimensions and symmetries of unit cells. Comment 20.2 The web site contains links to databases of X-ray diffraction patterns. 704 20 MATERIALS 2: THE SOLID STATE The method developed by the Braggs (William and his son Lawrence, who later jointly won the Nobel Prize) is the foundation of almost all modern work in X-ray crystallography. They used a single crystal and a monochromatic beam of X-rays, and rotated the crystal until a reflection was detected. There are many different sets of planes in a crystal, so there are many angles at which a reflection occurs. The complete set of data consists of the list of angles at which reflections are observed and their intensities. Single-crystal diffraction patterns are measured by using a four-circle diffractometer(Fig. 20.18). The computer linked to the diffractometer determines the unit cell dimensions and the angular settings of the diffractometer’s four circles that are needed to observe any particular intensity peak in the diffraction pattern. The computer controls the settings, and moves the crystal and the detector for each one in turn. At each setting, the diffraction intensity is measured, and background intensities are assessed by making measurements at slightly different settings. Computing techniques are now available that lead not only to automatic indexing but also to the automated determination of the shape, symmetry, and size of the unit cell. Moreover, several techniques are now available for sampling large amounts of data, including area detectors and image plates, which sample whole regions of diffraction patterns simultaneously. (b) Bragg’s law An early approach to the analysis of diffraction patterns produced by crystals was to regard a lattice plane as a semi-transparent mirror, and to model a crystal as stacks of reflecting lattice planes of separation d (Fig. 20.19). The model makes it easy to calculate the angle the crystal must make to the incoming beam of X-rays for constructive interference to occur. It has also given rise to the name reflection to denote an intense beam arising from constructive interference. Consider the reflection of two parallel rays of the same wavelength by two adjacent planes of a lattice, as shown in Fig. 20.19. One ray strikes point D on the upper plane but the other ray must travel an additional distance AB before striking the plane immediately below. Similarly, the reflected rays will differ in path length by a distance BC. The net path length difference of the two rays is then AB + BC = 2d sin θ where θ is the glancing angle. For many glancing angles the path-length difference is not an integer number of wavelengths, and the waves interfere largely destructively. However, when the path-length difference is an integer number of wavelengths (AB + BC = nλ), the reflected waves are in phase and interfere constructively. It follows that a reflection should be observed when the glancing angle satisfies Bragg’s law: nλ = 2d sin θ (20.4) Reflections with n = 2, 3, . . . are called second-order, third-order, and so on; they correspond to path-length differences of 2, 3, . . . wavelengths. In modern work it is normal to absorb the n into d, to write the Bragg law as λ = 2d sin θ (20.5) and to regard the nth-order reflection as arising from the {nh,nk,nl} planes (see Example 20.1). The primary use of Bragg’s law is in the determination of the spacing between the layers in the lattice for, once the angle θ corresponding to a reflection has been determined, d may readily be calculated. f 2 c Detector W Sample X-ray beam q Fig. 20.18 A four-circle diffractometer. The settings of the orientations (φ, χ, θ, and Ω) of the components is controlled by computer; each (hkl) reflection is monitored in turn, and their intensities are recorded. q d A C B q q Fig. 20.19 The conventional derivation of Bragg’s law treats each lattice plane as a reflecting the incident radiation. The path lengths differ by AB + BC, which depends on the glancing angle, θ. Constructive interference (a ‘reflection’) occurs when AB + BC is equal to an integer number of wavelengths. 20.3 THE INVESTIGATION OF STRUCTURE 705 Example 20.2 Using Bragg’s law A first-order reflection from the {111} planes of a cubic crystal was observed at a glancing angle of 11.2° when Cu(Kα) X-rays of wavelength 154 pm were used. What is the length of the side of the unit cell? Method The separation of the planes can be determined from Bragg’s law. Because the crystal is cubic, the separation is related to the length of the side of the unit cell, a, by eqn 20.2, which may therefore be solved for a. Answer According to eqn 20.5, the {111} planes responsible for the diffraction have separation d111 = The separation of the {111} planes of a cubic lattice of side a is given by eqn 20.2 as d111 = Therefore, a = = = 687 pm Self-test 20.2 Calculate the angle at which the same crystal will give a reflection from the {123} planes. [24.8°] Some types of unit cell give characteristic and easily recognizable patterns of lines. For example, in a cubic lattice of unit cell dimension a the spacing is given by eqn 20.2, so the angles at which the {hkl} planes give first-order reflections are given by sin θ = (h2 + k2 + l2 )1/2 The reflections are then predicted by substituting the values of h, k, and l: {hkl} {100} {110} {111} {200} {210} {211} {220} {300} {221} {310} . . . h2 +k2 +l2 1 2 3 4 5 6 8 9 9 10 . . . Notice that 7 (and 15, . . .) is missing because the sum of the squares of three integers cannot equal 7 (or 15, . . .). Therefore the pattern has absences that are characteristic of the cubic P lattice. Self-test 20.3 Normally, experimental procedures measure 2θ rather than θ itself. A diffraction examination of the element polonium gave lines at the following values of 2θ (in degrees) when 71.0 pm Mo X-rays were used: 12.1, 17.1, 21.0, 24.3, 27.2, 29.9, 34.7, 36.9, 38.9, 40.9, 42.8. Identify the unit cell and determine its dimensions. [cubic P; a = 337 pm] (c) Scattering factors To prepare the way to discussing modern methods of structural analysis we need to note that the scattering of X-rays is caused by the oscillations an incoming electromagnetic λ 2a 31/2 × (154 pm) 2 sin 11.2° 31/2 λ 2 sin θ a 31/2 λ 2 sin θ 706 20 MATERIALS 2: THE SOLID STATE wave generates in the electrons of atoms, and heavy atoms give rise to stronger scattering than light atoms. This dependence on the number of electrons is expressed in terms of the scattering factor, f, of the element. If the scattering factor is large, then the atoms scatter X-rays strongly. The scattering factor of an atom is related to the electron density distribution in the atom, ρ(r), by f = 4π Ύ ∞ 0 ρ(r) r2 dr k = sinθ (20.6) The value of f is greatest in the forward direction and smaller for directions away from the forward direction (Fig. 20.20). The detailed analysis of the intensities of reflections must take this dependence on direction into account (in single crystal studies as well as for powders). We show in the Justification below that, in the forward direction (for θ = 0), f is equal to the total number of electrons in the atom. Justification 20.1 The forward scattering factor As θ → 0, so k → 0. Because sin x = x − 1–6x3 + · · · , lim x→0 = lim x→0 = lim x→0 (1 − 1–6x2 + · · ·) = 1 The factor (sin kr)/kr is therefore equal to 1 for forward scattering. It follows that in the forward direction f = 4πΎ ∞ 0 ρ(r)r2 dr The integral over the electron density ρ (the number of electrons in an infinitesimal region divided by the volume of the region) multiplied by the volume element 4πr2 dr is the total number of electrons, Ne, in the atom. Hence, in the forward direction, f = Ne. For example, the scattering factors of Na+ , K+ , and Cl− are 8, 18, and 18, respectively. The scattering factor is smaller in nonforward directions because (sin kr)/kr < 1 for θ > 0, so the integral is smaller than the value calculated above. (d) The electron density The problem we now address is how to interpret the data from a diffractometer in terms of the detailed structure of a crystal. To do so, we must go beyond Bragg’s law. If a unit cell contains several atoms with scattering factors fj and coordinates (xja, yjb, zjc), then we show in the Justification below that the overall amplitude of a wave diffracted by the {hkl} planes is given by Fhkl = ∑ j fjeiφhkl(j) where φhkl(j) = 2π(hxj + kyj + lzj) (20.7) The sum is over all the atoms in the unit cell. The quantity Fhkl is called the structure factor. Justification 20.2 The structure factor We begin by showing that, if in the unit cell there is an A atom at the origin and a B atom at the coordinates (xa,yb,zc), where x, y, and z lie in the range 0 to 1, then the phase difference, φ, between the hkl reflections of the A and B atoms is φhkl = 2π(hx + ky + lz). x − 1–6x3 + · · · x sin x x 4π λ sin kr kr 10 30 20 Br- Fe 2+ Ca 2+ Cl - O C H f 0 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 1.20.2 (sin )/ 40 0 lq Fig. 20.20 The variation of the scattering factor of atoms and ions with atomic number and angle. The scattering factor in the forward direction (at θ = 0, and hence at (sin θ)/λ = 0) is equal to the number of electrons present in the species. 20.3 THE INVESTIGATION OF STRUCTURE 707 B B A A A A (a) (b) xa a xa Phase difference = 2px Phase difference 2 2= ´ px Phase difference = 2p Phase difference = 2 2´ p (100) (110) (111) (200) (210) (211) (220) (222) (310) (320) (321) (400) (331) (332) (420) (421) (422) (502), (430) (410), (322) (411), (330) (311) (221), (300) Face-centredcubic ,,allevenorall oddarepresent hkl Body-centredcubic oddare absent hkl++= Primitivecubic Fig. 20.22 The powder diffraction patterns and the systematic absences of three versions of a cubic cell. Comparison of the observed pattern with patterns like these enables the unit cell to be identified. The locations of the lines give the cell dimensions. Consider the crystal shown schematically in Fig. 20.21. The reflection corresponds to two waves from adjacent A planes, the phase difference of the waves being 2π. If there is a B atom at a fraction x of the distance between the two A planes, then it gives rise to a wave with a phase difference 2πx relative to an A reflection. To see this conclusion, note that, if x = 0, there is no phase difference; if x = 1–2 the phase difference is π; if x = 1, the B atom lies where the lower A atom is and the phase difference is 2π. Now consider a (200) reflection. There is now a 2 × 2π difference between the waves from the two A layers, and if B were to lie at x = 0.5 it would give rise to a wave that differed in phase by 2π from the wave from the upper A layer. Thus, for a general fractional position x, the phase difference for a (200) reflection is 2 × 2πx. For a general (h00) reflection, the phase difference is therefore h × 2πx. For three dimensions, this result generalizes to eqn 20.7. The A and B reflections interfere destructively when the phase difference is π, and the total intensity is zero if the atoms have the same scattering power. For example, if the unit cells are cubic I with a B atom at x = y = z = 1–2, then the A,B phase difference is (h + k + l)π. Therefore, all reflections for odd values of h + k + l vanish because the waves are displaced in phase by π. Hence the diffraction pattern for a cubic I lattice can be constructed from that for the cubic P lattice (a cubic lattice without points at the centre of its unit cells) by striking out all reflections with odd values of h + k + l. Recognition of these systematic absences in a powder spectrum immediately indicates a cubic I lattice (Fig. 20.22). If the amplitude of the waves scattered from A is fA at the detector, that of the waves scattered from B is fBeiφhkl, with φhkl the phase difference given in eqn 20.7. The total amplitude at the detector is therefore Fhkl = fA + fBeiφhkl Because the intensity is proportional to the square modulus of the amplitude of the wave, the intensity, Ihkl, at the detector is Ihkl ∝ F*hkl Fhkl = (fA + fBe−iφhkl)(fA + fBeiφhkl) This expression expands to Ihkl ∝ f 2 A + f 2 B + fA fB(eiφhkl + e−iφhkl) = f2 A + f2 B + 2fA fB cos φhkl The cosine term either adds to or subtracts from f2 A + f2 B depending on the value of φhkl, which in turn depends on h, k, and l and x, y, and z. Hence, there is a variation in the intensities of the lines with different hkl. Fig. 20.21 Diffraction from a crystal containing two kinds of atoms. (a) For a (100) reflection from the A planes, there is a phase difference of 2π between waves reflected by neighbouring planes. (b) For a (200) reflection, the phase difference is 4π. The reflection from a B plane at a fractional distance xa from an A plane has a phase that is x times these phase differences. 708 20 MATERIALS 2: THE SOLID STATE Cl Na(0,0,1) (1,1,0)(1,0,0) (1,1,1) (0,0,0) ( ,0,0) ( , ,0)-2 1 -2 1 -2 1 Fig. 20.23 The location of the atoms for the structure factor calculation in Example 20.3. The purple circles are Na+ ; the green circles are Cl− . Example 20.3 Calculating a structure factor Calculate the structure factors for the unit cell in Fig. 20.23. Method The structure factor is defined by eqn 20.7. To use this equation, consider the ions at the locations specified in Fig. 20.23. Write f + for the Na+ scattering factor and f − for the Cl− scattering factor. Note that ions in the body of the cell contribute to the scattering with a strength f. However, ions on faces are shared between two cells (use 1 –2 f ), those on edges by four cells (use 1 –4 f ), and those at corners by eight cells (use 1 –8 f ). Two useful relations are eiπ = −1 cos φ = 1 –2(eiφ + e−iφ ) Answer From eqn 20.7, and summing over the coordinates of all 27 atoms in the illustration: Fhkl = f + (1 –8 + 1 –8 e2πil + · · · + 1 –2e2πi(1–– 2h+1–– 2k+l) ) + f − (e2πi(1–– 2h+1–– 2k+1–– 2l) + 1 –4e2πi(1–– 2h) + · · · + 1 –4e2πi(1–– 2h+l) ) To simplify this 27-term expression, we use e2πih = e2πik = e2πil = 1 because h, k, and l are all integers: Fhkl = f + {1 + cos(h + k)π + cos(h + l)π + cos(k + l)π} + f − {(−1)h+k+l + cos kπ + cos lπ + cos hπ} Then, because cos hπ = (−1)h , Fhkl = f + {1 + (−1)h+k + (−1)h+l + (−1)l+k } + f − {(−1)h+k+l + (−1)h + (−1)k + (−1)l } Now note that: if h, k, and l are all even, Fhkl = f + {1 + 1 + 1 + 1} + f − {1 + 1 + 1 + 1} = 4(f + + f − ) if h, k, and l are all odd, Fhkl = 4(f + − f − ) if one index is odd and two are even, or vice versa, Fhkl = 0 The hkl all-odd reflections are less intense than the hkl all-even. For f + = f − , which is the case for identical atoms in a cubic P arrangement, the hkl all-odd have zero intensity, corresponding to the ‘systematic absences’ of cubic P unit cells. Self-test 20.4 Which reflections cannot be observed for a cubic I lattice? [for h + k + l odd, Fhkl = 0] The intensity of the (hkl) reflection is proportional to |Fhkl |2 , so in principle we can determine the structure factors experimentally by taking the square root of the corresponding intensities (but see below). Then, once we know all the structure factors Fhkl, we can calculate the electron density distribution, ρ(r), in the unit cell by using the expression ρ(r) = ∑ hkl Fhkle−2πi(hx+ky+lz) (20.8) where V is the volume of the unit cell. Equation 20.8 is called a Fourier synthesis of the electron density. 1 V 20.3 THE INVESTIGATION OF STRUCTURE 709 Electrondensity,(x) 0 0.5 1x 0 r Fig. 20.24 The plot of the electron density calculated in Example 20.4 (blue) and Self-test 20.5 (purple). Exploration If you do not have access to mathematical software, perform the calculations suggested in Self-test 20.5 by using the interactive applets found in the text’s web site. Example 20.4 Calculating an electron density by Fourier synthesis Consider the {h00} planes of a crystal extending indefinitely in the x-direction. In an X-ray analysis the structure factors were found as follows: h: 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 Fh 16 −10 2 −1 7 −10 8 −3 2 −3 h: 10 11 12 13 14 15 Fh 6 −5 3 −2 2 −3 (and F−h = Fh). Construct a plot of the electron density projected on to the x-axis of the unit cell. Method Because F−h = Fh, it follows from eqn 20.8 that Vρ(x) = ∞ ∑ h=−∞ Fhe−2πihx = F0 + ∞ ∑ h=1 (Fhe−2πihx + F−he2πihx ) = F0 + ∞ ∑ h=1 Fh(e−2πihx + e2πihx ) = F0 + 2 ∞ ∑ h=1 Fh cos 2πhx and we evaluate the sum (truncated at h = 15) for points 0 ≤ x ≤ 1 using mathematical software. Answer The results are plotted in Fig. 20.24 (blue line). The positions of three atoms can be discerned very readily. The more terms there are included, the more accurate the density plot. Terms corresponding to high values of h (short wavelength cosine terms in the sum) account for the finer details of the electron density; low values of h account for the broad features. Self-test 20.5 Use mathematical software to experiment with different structure factors (including changing signs as well as amplitudes). For example, use the same values of Fh as above, but with positive signs for h ≥ 6. [Fig. 20.24 (purple line)] (e) The phase problem A problem with the procedure outlined above is that the observed intensity Ihkl is proportional to the square modulus |Fhkl |2 , so we cannot say whether we should use +|Fhkl | or −|Fhkl | in the sum in eqn 20.8. In fact, the difficulty is more severe for noncentrosymmetric unit cells because, if we write Fhkl as the complex number |Fhkl |eiα , where α is the phase of Fhkl and |Fhkl | is its magnitude, then the intensity lets us determine |Fhkl | but tells us nothing of its phase, which may lie anywhere from 0 to 2π. This ambiguity is called the phase problem; its consequences are illustrated by comparing the two plots in Fig. 20.24. Some way must be found to assign phases to the structure factors, for otherwise the sum for ρ cannot be evaluated and the method would be useless. The phase problem can be overcome to some extent by a variety of methods. One procedure that is widely used for inorganic materials with a reasonably small number of atoms in a unit cell and for organic molecules with a small number of heavy atoms is the Patterson synthesis. Instead of the structure factors Fhkl, the values of |Fhkl |2 , which can be obtained without ambiguity from the intensities, are used in an expression that resembles eqn 20.8: 710 20 MATERIALS 2: THE SOLID STATE P(r) = ∑ hkl |Fhkl |2 e−2πi(hx+ky+lz) (20.9) The outcome of a Patterson synthesis is a map of the vector separations of the atoms (the distances and directions between atoms) in the unit cell. Thus, if atom A is at the coordinates (xA,yA,zA) and atom B is at (xB,yB,zB), then there will be a peak at (xA − xB, yA − yB, zA − zB) in the Patterson map. There will also be a peak at the negative of these coordinates, because there is a vector from B to A as well as a vector from A to B. The height of the peak in the map is proportional to the product of the atomic numbers of the two atoms, ZAZB. For example, if the unit cell has the structure shown in Fig. 20.25a, the Patterson synthesis would be the map shown in Fig. 20.25b, where the location of each spot relative to the origin gives the separation and relative orientation of each pair of atoms in the original structure. Heavy atoms dominate the scattering because their scattering factors are large, of the order of their atomic numbers, and their locations may be deduced quite readily. The sign of Fhkl can now be calculated from the locations of the heavy atoms in the unit cell, and to a high probability the phase calculated for them will be the same as the phase for the entire unit cell. To see why this is so, we have to note that a structure factor of a centrosymmetric cell has the form F = (±)fheavy + (±)flight + (±)flight + · · · (20.10) where fheavy is the scattering factor of the heavy atom and flight the scattering factors of the light atoms. The flight are all much smaller than fheavy, and their phases are more or less random if the atoms are distributed throughout the unit cell. Therefore, the net effect of the flight is to change F only slightly from fheavy, and we can be reasonably confident that F will have the same sign as that calculated from the location of the heavy atom. This phase can then be combined with the observed |F| (from the reflection intensity) to perform a Fourier synthesis of the full electron density in the unit cell, and hence to locate the light atoms as well as the heavy atoms. Modern structural analyses make extensive use of direct methods. Direct methods are based on the possibility of treating the atoms in a unit cell as being virtually randomly distributed (from the radiation’s point of view), and then using statistical techniques to compute the probabilities that the phases have a particular value. It is possible to deduce relations between some structure factors and sums (and sums of squares) of others, which have the effect of constraining the phases to particular values (with high probability, so long as the structure factors are large). For example, the Sayre probability relation has the form sign of Fh+h′,k+k′,l+l′ is probably equal to (sign of Fhkl) × (sign of Fh′k′l′) (20.11) For example, if F122 and F232 are both large and negative, then it is highly likely that F354, provided it is large, will be positive. (f) Structure refinement In the final stages of the determination of a crystal structure, the parameters describing the structure (atom positions, for instance) are adjusted systematically to give the best fit between the observed intensities and those calculated from the model of the structure deduced from the diffraction pattern. This process is called structure refinement. Not only does the procedure give accurate positions for all the atoms in the unit cell, but it also gives an estimate of the errors in those positions and in the bond lengths and angles derived from them. The procedure also provides information on the vibrational amplitudes of the atoms. 1 V R1 R1 R2 R2 R2 R3 R3 (a) (b) Fig. 20.25 The Patterson synthesis corresponding to the pattern in (a) is the pattern in (b). The distance and orientation of each spot from the origin gives the orientation and separation of one atom–atom separation in (a). Some of the typical distances and their contribution to (b) are shown as R1, etc. I20.1 IMPACT ON BIOCHEMISTRY: X-RAY CRYSTALLOGRAPHY OF BIOLOGICAL MACROMOLECULES 711 IMPACT ON BIOCHEMISTRY I20.1 X-ray crystallography of biological macromolecules X-ray crystallography is the deployment of X-ray diffraction techniques for the determination of the location of all the atoms in molecules as complicated as biopolymers. Bragg’s law helps us understand the features of one of the most seminal X-ray images of all time, the characteristic X-shaped pattern obtained by Rosalind Franklin and Maurice Wilkins from strands of DNA and used by James Watson and Francis Crick in their construction of the double-helix model of DNA (Fig. 20.26). To interpret this image by using the Bragg law we have to be aware that it was obtained by using a fibre consisting of many DNA molecules oriented with their axes parallel to the axis of the fibre, with X-rays incident from a perpendicular direction. All the molecules in the fibre are parallel (or nearly so), but are randomly distributed in the perpendicular directions; as a result, the diffraction pattern exhibits the periodic structure parallel to the fibre axis superimposed on a general background of scattering from the distribution of molecules in the perpendicular directions. There are two principal features in Fig. 20.26: the strong ‘meridional’ scattering upward and downward by the fibre and the X-shaped distribution at smaller scattering angles. Because scattering through large angles occurs for closely spaced features (from λ = 2d sin θ, if d is small, then θ must be large to preserve the equality), we can infer that the meridional scattering arises from closely spaced components and that the inner X-shaped pattern arises from features with a longer periodicity. Because the meridional pattern occurs at a distance of about 10 times that of the innermost spots of the X-pattern, the large-scale structure is about 10 times bigger than the small-scale structure. From the geometry of the instrument, the wavelength of the radiation, and Bragg’s law, we can infer that the periodicity of the small-scale feature is 340 pm whereas that of the large-scale feature is 3400 pm (that is, 3.4 nm). To see that the cross is characteristic of a helix, look at Fig. 20.27. Each turn of the helix defines two planes, one orientated at an angle α to the horizontal and the other at −α. As a result, to a first approximation, a helix can be thought of as consisting of an array of planes at an angle α together with an array of planes at an angle −α with a separation within each set determined by the pitch of the helix. Thus, a DNA molecule is like two arrays of planes, each set corresponding to those treated in the derivation of Bragg’s law, with a perpendicular separation d = p cos α, where p is the pitch of the helix, each canted at the angles ±α to the horizontal. The diffraction spots from one set of planes therefore occur at an angle α to the vertical, giving one leg of the X, and those of the other set occur at an angle −α, giving rise to the other leg of the X. The Fig. 20.26 The X-ray diffraction pattern obtained from a fibre of B-DNA. The black dots are the reflections, the points of maximum constructive interference, that are used to determine the structure of the molecule. (Adapted from an illustration that appears in J.P. Glusker and K.N. Trueblood, Crystal structure analysis: A primer. Oxford University Press (1972).) (a) (b) (c) a a Fig. 20.27 The origin of the X pattern characteristic of diffraction by a helix. (a) A helix can be thought of as consisting of an array of planes at an angle α together with an array of planes at an angle −α. (b) The diffraction spots from one set of planes appear at an angle α to the vertical, giving one leg of the X, and those of the other set appear at an angle −α, giving rise to the other leg of the X. The lower half of the X appears because the helix has up–down symmetry in this arrangement. (c) The sequence of spots outward along a leg of the X corresponds to first-, second-, . . . order diffraction (n = 1, 2, . . . ). 712 20 MATERIALS 2: THE SOLID STATE experimental arrangement has up–down symmetry, so the diffraction pattern repeats to produce the lower half of the X. The sequence of spots outward along a leg corresponds to first-, second-, . . . order diffraction (n = 1, 2, . . . in eqn 20.4). Therefore from the X-ray pattern, we see at once that the molecule is helical and we can measure the angle α directly, and find α = 40°. Finally, with the angle α and the pitch p determined, we can determine the radius r of the helix from tan α = p/4r, from which it follows that r = (3.4 nm)/(4 tan 40°) = 1.0 nm. To derive the relation between the helix and the cross-like pattern we have ignored the detailed structure of the helix, the fact that it is a periodic array of nucleotide bases, not a smooth wire. In Fig. 20.28 we represent the bases by points, and see that there is an additional periodicity of separation h, forming planes that are perpendicular to the axis to the molecule (and the fibre). These planes give rise to the strong meridional diffraction with an angle that allows us to determine the layer spacing from Bragg’s law in the form λ = 2h sin θ as h = 340 pm. The success of modern biochemistry in explaining such processes as DNA replication, protein biosynthesis, and enzyme catalysis is a direct result of developments in preparatory, instrumental, and computational procedures that have led to the determination of large numbers of structures of biological macromolecules by techniques based on X-ray diffraction. Most work is now done not on fibres but on crystals, in which the large molecules lie in orderly ranks. A technique that works well for charged proteins consists of adding large amounts of a salt, such as (NH4)2SO4, to a buffer solution containing the biopolymer. The increase in the ionic strength of the solution decreases the solubility of the protein to such an extent that the protein precipitates, sometimes as crystals that are amenable to analysis by X-ray diffraction. Other common strategies for inducing crystallization involve the gradual removal of solvent from a biopolymer solution, either by dialysis (Impact I5.2) or vapour diffusion. In one implementation of the vapour diffusion method, a single drop of biopolymer solution hangs above an aqueous solution (the reservoir), as shown in Fig. 20.29. If the reservoir solution is more concentrated in a non-volatile solute (for example, a salt) than is the biopolymer solution, then solvent will evaporate slowly from the drop until the vapour pressure of water in the closed container reaches a constant, equilibrium value. At the same time, the concentration of biopolymer in the drop increases gradually until crystals begin to form. Special techniques are used to crystallize hydrophobic proteins, such as those spanning the bilayer of a cell membrane. In such cases, surfactant molecules, which like phospholipids contain polar head groups and hydrophobic tails, are used to encase the protein molecules and make them soluble in aqueous buffer solutions. Dialysis or vapour diffusion may then be used to induce crystallization. After suitable crystals are obtained, X-ray diffraction data are collected and analysed as described in the previous sections. The three-dimensional structures of a very h (a) (b) (c) Fig. 20.28 The effect of the internal structure of the helix on the X-ray diffraction pattern. (a) The residues of the macromolecule are represented by points. (b) Parallel planes passing through the residues are perpendicular to the axis of the molecule. (c) The planes give rise to strong diffraction with an angle that allows us to determine the layer spacing h from λ = 2h sin θ. Drop of biopolymer solution Reservoir solution Fig. 20.29 In a common implementation of the vapour diffusion method of biopolymer crystallization, a single drop of biopolymer solution hangs above a reservoir solution that is very concentrated in a non-volatile solute. Solvent evaporates from the more dilute drop until the vapour pressure of water in the closed container reaches a constant equilibrium value. In the course of evaporation (denoted by the downward arrows), the biopolymer solution becomes more concentrated and, at some point, crystals may form. 20.4 NEUTRON AND ELECTRON DIFFRACTION 713 large number of biological polymers have been determined in this way. However, the techniques discussed so far give only static pictures and are not useful in studies of dynamics and reactivity. This limitation stems from the fact that the Bragg rotation method requires stable crystals that do not change structure during the lengthy data acquisition times required. However, special time-resolved X-ray diffraction techniques have become available in recent years and it is now possible to make exquisitely detailed measurements of atomic motions during chemical and biochemical reactions. Time-resolved X-ray diffraction techniques make use of synchrotron sources, which can emit intense polychromatic pulses of X-ray radiation with pulse widths varying from 100 ps to 200 ps (1 ps = 10−12 s). Instead of the Bragg method, the Laue method is used because many reflections can be collected simultaneously, rotation of the sample is not required, and data acquisition times are short. However, good diffraction data cannot be obtained from a single X-ray pulse and reflections from several pulses must be averaged together. In practice, this averaging dictates the time resolution of the experiment, which is commonly tens of microseconds or less. An example of the power of time-resolved X-ray crystallography is the elucidation of structural changes that accompany the activation by light of the photoactive yellow protein of the bacterium Ectothiorhodospira halophila. Within 1 ns after absorption of a photon of 446 nm light, a protein-bound phenolate ion undergoes trans–cis isomerization to form the intermediate shown in Fig. 20.30. A series of rearrangements then follows, which includes the ejection of the ion from its binding site deep in the protein, its return to the site, and re-formation of the cis conformation. The physiological outcome of this cycle is a negative phototactic response, or movement of the organism away from light. Time-resolved X-ray diffraction studies in the nanosecond to millisecond ranges identified a number of structural changes that follow electronic excitation of the phenolate ion with a laser pulse: isomerization, ejection, protonation of the exposed ion, and a number of amino acid motions. 20.4 Neutron and electron diffraction According to the de Broglie relation (eqn 8.12, λ = h/p), particles have wavelengths and may therefore undergo diffraction. Neutrons generated in a nuclear reactor and then slowed to thermal velocities have wavelengths similar to those of X-rays and may also be used for diffraction studies. For instance, a neutron generated in a reactor and slowed to thermal velocities by repeated collisions with a moderator (such as graphite) until it is travelling at about 4 km s−1 has a wavelength of about 100 pm. In practice, a range of wavelengths occurs in a neutron beam, but a monochromatic beam can be selected by diffraction from a crystal, such as a single crystal of germanium. Comment 20.3 The text’s web site contains links to databases of structures of biological macromolecules. Fig. 20.30 Light-induced isomerization of a protein-bound phenolate ion in the photoactive yellow protein of the bacterium Ectothiorhodospira halophila. 714 20 MATERIALS 2: THE SOLID STATE Fig. 20.31 If the spins of atoms at lattice points are orderly, as in this material, where the spins of one set of atoms are aligned antiparallel to those of the other set, neutron diffraction detects two interpenetrating simple cubic lattices on account of the magnetic interaction of the neutron with the atoms, but X-ray diffraction would see only a single bcc lattice. Example 20.5 Calculating the typical wavelength of thermal neutrons Calculate the typical wavelength of neutrons that have reached thermal equilibrium with their surroundings at 373 K. Method We need to relate the wavelength to the temperature. There are two linking steps. First, the de Broglie relation expresses the wavelength in terms of the linear momentum. Then the linear momentum can be expressed in terms of the kinetic energy, the mean value of which is given in terms of the temperature by the equipartition theorem (see Section 17.3). Answer From the equipartition principle, we know that the mean translational kinetic energy of a neutron at a temperature T travelling in the x-direction is EK = 1 –2kT. The kinetic energy is also equal to p2 /2m, where p is the momentum of the neutron and m is its mass. Hence, p = (mkT)1/2 . It follows from the de Broglie relation λ = h/p that the neutron’s wavelength is λ = Therefore, at 373 K, λ = = = 2.26 × 10−10 m = 226 pm where we have used 1 J = 1 kg m2 s−2 . Self-test 20.6 Calculate the temperature needed for the average wavelength of the neutrons to be 100 pm. [1.90 × 103 K] Neutron diffraction differs from X-ray diffraction in two main respects. First, the scattering of neutrons is a nuclear phenomenon. Neutrons pass through the extranuclear electrons of atoms and interact with the nuclei through the ‘strong force’ that is responsible for binding nucleons together. As a result, the intensity with which neutrons are scattered is independent of the number of electrons and neighbouring elements in the periodic table may scatter neutrons with markedly different intensities. Neutron diffraction can be used to distinguish atoms of elements such as Ni and Co that are present in the same compound and to study order–disorder phase transitions in FeCo. A second difference is that neutrons possess a magnetic moment due to their spin. This magnetic moment can couple to the magnetic fields of atoms or ions in a crystal (if the ions have unpaired electrons) and modify the diffraction pattern. One consequence is that neutron diffraction is well suited to the investigation of magnetically ordered lattices in which neighbouring atoms may be of the same element but have different orientations of their electronic spin (Fig. 20.31). Electrons accelerated through a potential difference of 40 kV have wavelengths of about 6 pm, and so are also suitable for diffraction studies. However, their main application is to the study of surfaces, and we postpone their discussion until Chapter 25. J s (kg2 m2 s−2 )1/2 6.626 × 10−34 (1.675 × 1.381 × 373 × 10−50 )1/2 6.626 × 10−34 J s {(1.675 × 10−27 kg) × (1.381 × 10−23 J K−1 ) × (373 K)}1/2 h (mkT)1/2 20.5 METALLIC SOLIDS 715 Crystal structure The bonding within a solid may be of various kinds. Simplest of all (in principle) are elemental metals, where electrons are delocalized over arrays of identical cations and bind them together into a rigid but ductile and malleable whole. 20.5 Metallic solids Most metallic elements crystallize in one of three simple forms, two of which can be explained in terms of hard spheres packing together in the closest possible arrangement. (a) Close packing Figure 20.32 shows a close-packed layer of identical spheres, one with maximum utilization of space. A close-packed three-dimensional structure is obtained by stacking such close-packed layers on top of one another. However, this stacking can be done in different ways, which result in close-packed polytypes, or structures that are identical in two dimensions (the close-packed layers) but differ in the third dimension. In all polytypes, the spheres of second close-packed layer lie in the depressions of the first layer (Fig. 20.33). The third layer may be added in either of two ways. In one, the spheres are placed so that they reproduce the first layer (Fig. 20.34a), to give an ABA pattern of layers. Alternatively, the spheres may be placed over the gaps in the first layer (Fig. 20.34b), so giving an ABC pattern. Two polytypes are formed if the two stacking patterns are repeated in the vertical direction. If the ABA pattern is repeated, to give the sequence of layers ABABAB . . . , the spheres are hexagonallyclose-packed Fig. 20.34 (a) The third layer of close-packed spheres might occupy the dips lying directly above the spheres in the first layer, resulting in an ABA structure, which corresponds to hexagonal close-packing. (b) Alternatively, the third layer might lie in the dips that are not above the spheres in the first layer, resulting in an ABC structure, which corresponds to cubic close-packing Fig. 20.32 The first layer of close-packed spheres used to build a three-dimensional close-packed structure. Fig. 20.33 The second layer of close-packed spheres occupies the dips of the first layer. The two layers are the AB component of the close-packed structure. (a) (b) 716 20 MATERIALS 2: THE SOLID STATE (hcp). Alternatively, if the ABC pattern is repeated, to give the sequence ABCABC . . . , the spheres are cubic close-packed (ccp). We can see the origins of these names by referring to Fig. 20.35. The ccp structure gives rise to a face-centred unit cell, so may also be denoted cubic F (or fcc, for face-centred cubic).2 It is also possible to have random sequences of layers; however, the hcp and ccp polytypes are the most important. Table 20.2 lists some elements possessing these structures. The compactness of close-packed structures is indicated by their coordination number, the number of atoms immediately surrounding any selected atom, which is 12 in all cases. Another measure of their compactness is the packingfraction, the fraction of space occupied by the spheres, which is 0.740 (see the following Justification). That is, in a close-packed solid of identical hard spheres, only 26.0 per cent of the volume is empty space. The fact that many metals are close-packed accounts for their high densities. Justification 20.3 The packing fraction To calculate a packing fraction of a ccp structure, we first calculate the volume of a unit cell, and then calculate the total volume of the spheres that fully or partially occupy it. The first part of the calculation is a straightforward exercise in geometry. The second part involves counting the fraction of spheres that occupy the cell. Refer to Fig. 20.36. Because a diagonal of any face passes completely through one sphere and halfway through two other spheres, its length is 4R. The length of a side is therefore 81/2 R and the volume of the unit cell is 83/2 R3 . Because each cell contains the equivalent of 6 × 1–2 + 8 × 1–8 = 4 spheres, and the volume of each sphere is 4–3πR3 , the total occupied volume is 16–3 πR3 . The fraction of space occupied is therefore 16–3 πR3 /83/2 R3 =16–3 π/83/2 , or 0.740. Because an hcp structure has the same coordination number, its packing fraction is the same. The packing fractions of structures that are not close-packed are calculated similarly (see Exercises 20.14 and 20.17 and Problem 20.24). (b) Less closely packed structures As shown in Table 20.2, a number of common metals adopt structures that are less than close-packed. The departure from close packing suggests that factors such as specific covalent bonding between neighbouring atoms are beginning to influence the structure and impose a specific geometrical arrangement. One such arrangement results in a cubic I (bcc, for body-centred cubic) structure, with one sphere at the centre of a cube formed by eight others. The coordination number of a bcc structure is Table 20.2 The crystal structures of some elements Structure Element hcp* Be, Cd, Co, He, Mg, Sc, Ti, Zn fcc* (ccp, cubic F) Ag, Al, Ar, Au, Ca, Cu, Kr, Ne, Ni, Pd, Pb, Pt, Rh, Rn, Sr, Xe bcc (cubic I) Ba, Cs, Cr, Fe, K, Li, Mn, Mo, Rb, Na, Ta, W, V cubic P Po * Close-packed structures. (a) (b) Fig. 20.35 A fragment of the structure shown in Fig. 20.34 revealing the (a) hexagonal (b) cubic symmetry. The tints on the spheres are the same as for the layers in Fig. 20.34. 2 Strictly speaking, ccp refers to a close-packed arrangement whereas fcc refers to the lattice type of the common representation of ccp. However, this distinction is rarely made. 4R 8 1/2 R 8 1/ 2 R Fig. 20.36 The calculation of the packing fraction of an ccp unit cell. 20.6 IONIC SOLIDS 717 only 8, but there are six more atoms not much further away than the eight nearest neighbours. The packing fraction of 0.68 is not much smaller than the value for a close-packed structure (0.74), and shows that about two-thirds of the available space is actually occupied. 20.6 Ionic solids Two questions arise when we consider ionic solids: the relative locations adopted by the ions and the energetics of the resulting structure. (a) Structure When crystals of compounds of monatomic ions (such as NaCl and MgO) are modelled by stacks of hard spheres it is essential to allow for the different ionic radii (typically with the cations smaller than the anions) and different charges. The coordinationnumber of an ion is the number of nearest neighbours of opposite charge; the structure itself is characterized as having (n+,n−) coordination, where n+ is the coordination number of the cation and n− that of the anion. Even if, by chance, the ions have the same size, the problems of ensuring that the unit cells are electrically neutral makes it impossible to achieve 12-coordinate closepacked ionic structures. As a result, ionic solids are generally less dense than metals. The best packing that can be achieved is the (8,8)-coordinate caesium-chloridestructure in which each cation is surrounded by eight anions and each anion is surrounded by eight cations (Fig. 20.37). In this structure, an ion of one charge occupies the centre of a cubic unit cell with eight counter ions at its corners. The structure is adopted by CsCl itself and also by CaS, CsCN (with some distortion), and CuZn. When the radii of the ions differ more than in CsCl, even eight-coordinate packing cannot be achieved. One common structure adopted is the (6,6)-coordinate rock-salt structure typified by NaCl (Fig. 20.38). In this structure, each cation is surrounded by six anions and each anion is surrounded by six cations. The rock-salt structure can be pictured as consisting of two interpenetrating slightly expanded cubic F (fcc) arrays, one composed of cations and the other of anions. This structure is adopted by NaCl itself and also by several other MX compounds, including KBr, AgCl, MgO, and ScN. The switch from the caesium-chloride structure to the rock-salt structure is related to the value of the radius ratio, γ: γ = [20.12] The two radii are those of the larger and smaller ions in the crystal. The radius-ratio rule states that the caesium-chloride structure should be expected when γ > 31/2 − 1 = 0.732 and that the rock-salt structure should be expected when 21/2 − 1 = 0.414 < γ < 0.732. For γ < 0.414, the most efficient packing leads to four-coordination of the type exhibited by the sphalerite (or zinc blende) form of ZnS (Fig. 20.39). The rule is derived by considering the geometrical problem of packing the maximum number of hard spheres of one radius around a hard sphere of a different radius. The deviation of a structure from that expected on the basis of the radius-ratio rule is often taken to be an indication of a shift from ionic towards covalent bonding; however, a major source of unreliability is the arbitrariness of ionic radii and their variation with coordination number. Ionic radii are derived from the distance between centres of adjacent ions in a crystal. However, we need to apportion the total distance between the two ions by defining the radius of one ion and then inferring the radius of the other ion. One scale that is widely used is based on the value 140 pm for the radius of the O2− ion (Table 20.3). rsmaller rlarger Cs Cl Fig. 20.37 The caesium-chloride structure consists of two interpenetrating simple cubic arrays of ions, one of cations and the other of anions, so that each cube of ions of one kind has a counter-ion at its centre. S Zn Fig. 20.39 The structure of the sphalerite form of ZnS showing the location of the Zn atoms in the tetrahedral holes formed by the array of S atoms. (There is an S atom at the centre of the cube inside the tetrahedron of Zn atoms.) Cl Na Fig. 20.38 The rock-salt (NaCl) structure consists of two mutually interpenetrating slightly expanded face-centred cubic arrays of ions. The entire assembly shown here is the unit cell. 718 20 MATERIALS 2: THE SOLID STATE Other scales are also available (such as one based on F− for discussing halides), and it is essential not to mix values from different scales. Because ionic radii are so arbitrary, predictions based on them must be viewed cautiously. (b) Energetics The lattice energy of a solid is the difference in potential energy of the ions packed together in a solid and widely separated as a gas. The lattice energy is always positive; a high lattice energy indicates that the ions interact strongly with one another to give a tightly bonded solid. The lattice enthalpy, ∆HL, is the change in standard molar enthalpy for the process MX(s) → M+ (g) + X− (g) and its equivalent for other charge types and stoichiometries. The lattice enthalpy is equal to the lattice energy at T = 0; at normal temperatures they differ by only a few kilojoules per mole, and the difference is normally neglected. Each ion in a solid experiences electrostatic attractions from all the other oppositely charged ions and repulsions from all the other like-charged ions. The total Coulombic potential energy is the sum of all the electrostatic contributions. Each cation is surrounded by anions, and there is a large negative contribution from the attraction of the opposite charges. Beyond those nearest neighbours, there are cations that contribute a positive term to the total potential energy of the central cation. There is also a negative contribution from the anions beyond those cations, a positive contribution from the cations beyond them, and so on to the edge of the solid. These repulsions and attractions become progressively weaker as the distance from the central ion increases, but the net outcome of all these contributions is a lowering of energy. First, consider a simple one-dimensional model of a solid consisting of a long line of uniformly spaced alternating cations and anions, with d the distance between their centres, the sum of the ionic radii (Fig. 20.40). If the charge numbers of the ions have the same absolute value (+1 and −1, or +2 and −2, for instance), then z1 = +z, z2 = −z, and z1z2 = −z2 . The potential energy of the central ion is calculated by summing all the terms, with negative terms representing attractions to oppositely charged ions and positive terms representing repulsions from like-charged ions. For the interaction with ions extending in a line to the right of the central ion, the lattice energy is EP = × − + − + − · · · = − 1 − + − + · · · = − × ln 2 We have used the relation 1 − 1 –2 + 1 –3 − 1 –4 + · · · = ln 2. Finally, we multiply EP by 2 to obtain the total energy arising from interactions on each side of the ion and then multiply by Avogadro’s constant, NA, to obtain an expression for the lattice energy per mole of ions. The outcome is EP = −2 ln 2 × with d = rcation + ranion. This energy is negative, corresponding to a net attraction. The calculation we have just performed can be extended to three-dimensional arrays of ions with different charges: z2 NAe2 4πε0d z2 e2 4πε0d D F 1 4 1 3 1 2 A C z2 e2 4πε0d D F z2 e2 4d z2 e2 3d z2 e2 2d z2 e2 d A C 1 4πε0 d +z -z +z +z-z -z Fig. 20.40 A line of alternating cations and ions used in the calculation of the Madelung constant in one dimension. Synoptic table 20.3* Ionic radii, r/pm Na+ 102(6†), 116(8) K+ 138(6), 151(8) F− 128(2), 131(4) Cl− 181 (close packing) * More values are given in the Data section. † Coordination number. 20.6 IONIC SOLIDS 719 EP = −A × (20.13) The factor A is a positive numerical constant called the Madelung constant; its value depends on how the ions are arranged about one another. For ions arranged in the same way as in sodium chloride, A = 1.748. Table 20.4 lists Madelung constants for other common structures. There are also repulsions arising from the overlap of the atomic orbitals of the ions and the role of the Pauli principle. These repulsions are taken into account by supposing that, because wavefunctions decay exponentially with distance at large distances from the nucleus, and repulsive interactions depend on the overlap of orbitals, the repulsive contribution to the potential energy has the form E*P = NAC′e−d/d* (20.14) with C′ and d* constants; the latter is commonly taken to be 34.5 pm. The total potential energy is the sum of EP and E*P, and passes through a minimum when d(EP + E*P)/dd = 0 (Fig. 20.41). A short calculation leads to the following expression for the minimum total potential energy (see Exercise 20.21a): EP,min = − 1 − A (20.15) This expression is called the Born–Mayer equation. Provided we ignore zero-point contributions to the energy, we can identify the negative of this potential energy with the lattice energy. We see that large lattice energies are expected when the ions are highly charged (so |zAzB| is large) and small (so d is small). Experimental values of the lattice enthalpy (the enthalpy, rather than the energy) are obtained by using a Born–Haber cycle, a closed path of transformations starting and ending at the same point, one step of which is the formation of the solid compound from a gas of widely separated ions. A typical cycle, for potassium chloride, is shown in Fig. 20.42. It consists of the following steps (for convenience, starting at the elements): DH/(kJ mol−1 ) 1. Sublimation of K(s) +89 [dissociation enthalpy of K(s)] 2. Dissociation of 1 –2 Cl2(g) +122 [1 –2 × dissociation enthalpy of Cl2(g)] 3. Ionization of K(g) +418 [ionization enthalpy of K(g)] 4. Electron attachment to Cl(g) −349 [electron gain enthalpy of Cl(g)] 5. Formation of solid from gas −∆HL/(kJ mol−1 ) 6. Decomposition of compound +437 [negative of enthalpy of formation of KCl(s)] Because the sum of these enthalpy changes is equal to zero, we can infer from 89 + 122 + 418 − 349 − ∆HL/(kJ mol−1 ) + 437 = 0 that ∆HL = +717 kJ mol−1 . Some lattice enthalpies obtained in this way are listed in Table 20.5. As can be seen from the data, the trends in values are in general accord with the predictions of the Born–Mayer equation. Agreement is typically taken to imply that the ionic model of bonding is valid for the substance; disagreement implies that there is a covalent contribution to the bonding. D F d* d A C NA|zAzB|e2 4πε0d |z1z2|NAe2 4πε0d Table 20.4 Madelung constants Structural type* A Caesium chloride 1.763 Fluorite 2.519 Rock salt 1.748 Rutile 2.408 Sphalerite 1.638 Wurtzite 1.641 * For descriptions of the structural types not covered in this chapter, see references in Further reading. Repulsion Attraction Lattice parameter Potentialenergy 0 Fig. 20.42 The Born–Haber cycle for KCl at 298 K. Enthalpies changes are in kilojoules per mole. KCl(s) K(s) Cl (g)+ 2 K(g) Cl (g)+ 2 K(g) Cl(g)+ K (g) e (g) Cl(g)+ + +K (g) Cl (g)+ + - +437 +89 +122 +418 -349 -DHL 1 2- 1 2Fig. 20.41 The contributions to the total potential energy of an ionic crystal. 720 20 MATERIALS 2: THE SOLID STATE 20.7 Molecular solids and covalent networks X-ray diffraction studies of solids reveal a huge amount of information, including interatomic distances, bond angles, stereochemistry, and vibrational parameters. In this section we can do no more than hint at the diversity of types of solids found when molecules pack together or atoms link together in extended networks. In covalent network solids, covalent bonds in a definite spatial orientation link the atoms in a network extending through the crystal. The demands of directional bonding, which have only a small effect on the structures of many metals, now override the geometrical problem of packing spheres together, and elaborate and extensive structures may be formed. Examples include silicon, red phosphorus, boron nitride, and— very importantly—diamond, graphite, and carbon nanotubes, which we discuss in detail. Diamond and graphite are two allotropes of carbon. In diamond each sp3 -hybridized carbon is bonded tetrahedrally to its four neighbours (Fig. 20.43). The network of strong C-C bonds is repeated throughout the crystal and, as a result, diamond is the hardest known substance. In graphite, σ bonds between sp2 -hybridized carbon atoms form hexagonal rings which, when repeated throughout a plane, give rise to sheets (Fig. 20.44). Because the sheets can slide against each other when impurities are present, graphite is used widely as a lubricant. Carbon nanotubes are thin cylinders of carbon atoms that are both mechanically strong and highly conducting (see Impact I20.2). They are synthesized by condensing a carbon plasma either in the presence or absence of a catalyst. The simplest structural motif is called a single-walled nanotube (SWNT) and is shown in Fig. 20.45. In a SWNT, sp2 -hybridized carbon atoms form hexagonal rings reminiscent of the structure of the carbon sheets found in graphite. The tubes have diameters between 1 and 2 nm and lengths of several micrometres. The features shown in Fig. 20.45 have been confirmed by direct visualization with scanning tunnelling microscopy (Impact I9.1). A multi-walled nanotube (MWNT) consists of several concentric SWNTs and its diameter varies between 2 and 25 nm. Molecular solids, which are the subject of the overwhelming majority of modern structural determinations, are held together by van der Waals interactions (Chapter 18). The observed crystal structure is Nature’s solution to the problem of condensing objects of various shapes into an aggregate of minimum energy (actually, for T > 0, of Synoptic table 20.5* Lattice enthalpies at 298 K, ∆HL/(kJ mol−1 ) NaF 787 NaBr 751 MgO 3850 MgS 3406 * More values are given in the Data section. Comment 20.4 Allotropes are distinct forms of an element that differ in the way that atoms are linked. For example, oxygen has two allotropes: O2 and O3 (ozone). (a) (b) Fig. 20.43 A fragment of the structure of diamond. Each C atom is tetrahedrally bonded to four neighbours. This framework-like structure results in a rigid crystal. Fig. 20.44 Graphite consists of flat planes of hexagons of carbon atoms lying above one another. (a) The arrangement of carbon atoms in a sheet; (b) the relative arrangement of neighbouring sheets. When impurities are present, the planes can slide over one another easily. Fig. 20.45 In a single-walled nanotube (SWNT), sp2 -hybridized carbon atoms form hexagonal rings that grow as tubes with diameters between 1 and 2 nm and lengths of several micrometres. 20.8 MECHANICAL PROPERTIES 721 minimum Gibbs energy). The prediction of the structure is a very difficult task, but software specifically designed to explore interaction energies can now make reasonably reliable predictions. The problem is made more complicated by the role of hydrogen bonds, which in some cases dominate the crystal structure, as in ice (Fig. 20.46), but in others (for example, in phenol) distort a structure that is determined largely by the van der Waals interactions. The properties of solids In this section we consider how the bulk properties of solids, particularly their mechanical, electrical, optical, and magnetic properties, stem from the properties of their constituent atoms. The rational fabrication of modern materials depends crucially on an understanding of this link. 20.8 Mechanical properties The fundamental concepts for the discussion of the mechanical properties of solids are stress and strain. The stress on an object is the applied force divided by the area to which it is applied. The strain is the resulting distortion of the sample. The general field of the relations between stress and strain is called rheology. Stress may be applied in a number of different ways. Thus, uniaxial stress is a simple compression or extension in one direction (Fig. 20.47); hydrostatic stress is a stress applied simultaneously in all directions, as in a body immersed in a fluid. A pure shear is a stress that tends to push opposite faces of the sample in opposite directions. A sample subjected to a small stress typically undergoes elastic deformation in the sense that it recovers its original shape when the stress is removed. For low stresses, the strain is linearly proportional to the stress. The response becomes nonlinear at high stresses but may remain elastic. Above a certain threshold, the strain becomes plastic in the sense that recovery does not occur when the stress is removed. Plastic deformation occurs when bond breaking takes place and, in pure metals, typically takes place through the agency of dislocations. Brittle solids, such as ionic solids, exhibit sudden fracture as the stress focused by cracks causes them to spread catastrophically. The response of a solid to an applied stress is commonly summarized by a number of coefficients of proportionality known as ‘moduli’: Fig. 20.46 A fragment of the crystal structure of ice (ice-I). Each O atom is at the centre of a tetrahedron of four O atoms at a distance of 276 pm. The central O atom is attached by two short O-H bonds to two H atoms and by two long hydrogen bonds to the H atoms of two of the neighbouring molecules. Overall, the structure consists of planes of hexagonal puckered rings of H2O molecules (like the chair form of cyclohexane). Comment 20.5 The web site contains links to databases of properties of materials, such as metals and polymers. (a) (b) (c) Fig. 20.47 Types of stress applied to a body. (a) Uniaxial stress, (b) shear stress, (c) hydrostatic pressure. 722 20 MATERIALS 2: THE SOLID STATE Young’s modulus: E = [20.16a] Bulk modulus: K = [20.16b] Shear modulus: G = [20.16c] where ‘normal stress’ refers to stretching and compression of the material, as shown in Fig. 20.48a and ‘shear stress’ refers to the stress depicted in Fig. 20.48b. The bulk modulus is the inverse of the isothermal compressibility, κ, first encountered in Section 2.11 (eqn 2.44, κ = −(∂V/∂p)T/V). A third ratio indicates how the sample changes its shape: Poisson’s ratio: νP = [20.17] The moduli are interrelated: G = K = (20.18) We can use thermodynamic arguments to discover the relation of the moduli to the molecular properties of the solid. Thus, in the Justification below, we show that, if neighbouring molecules interact by a Lennard-Jones potential, then the bulk modulus and the compressibility of the solid are related to the Lennard-Jones parameter ε (the depth of the potential well) by K = κ = (20.19) We see that the bulk modulus is large (the solid stiff) if the potential well represented by the Lennard-Jones potential is deep and the solid is dense (its molar volume small). Justification 20.4 The relation between compressibility and molecular interactions First, we combine the definition of K = 1/κ, with the thermodynamic relation p = −(∂U/∂V)T (this is eqn 3.45), to obtain K = V T This expression shows that the bulk modulus (and through eqn 20.18, the other two moduli) depends on the curvature of a plot of the internal energy against volume. To develop this conclusion, we note that the variation of internal energy with volume can be expressed in terms of its variation with a lattice parameter, R, such as the length of the side of a unit cell. = and so = + = + 2 To calculate K at the equilibrium volume of the sample, we set R = R0 and recognize that ∂U/∂R = 0 at equilibrium, so D E F ∂R ∂V A B C ∂2 U ∂R2 ∂2 R ∂V2 ∂U ∂R ∂R ∂V ∂2 U ∂V∂R ∂2 R ∂V2 ∂U ∂R ∂2 U ∂V2 ∂R ∂V ∂U ∂R ∂U ∂V D E F ∂2 U ∂V2 A B C Vm 8NAε 8NAε Vm E 3(1 − 2νP) E 2(1 + νP) transverse strain normal strain shear stress shear strain pressure fractional change in volume normal stress normal strain Normal strain Transverse strain Shear stress (a) (b) Fig. 20.48 (a) Normal stress and the resulting strain. (b) Shear stress. Poisson’s ratio indicates the extent to which a body changes shape when subjected to a uniaxial stress. 20.9 ELECTRICAL PROPERTIES 723 K = V T,0 2 T,0 where the 0 denotes that the derivatives are evaluated at the equilibrium dimensions of the unit cell by setting R = R0 after the derivative has been calculated. At this point we can write V = aR3 , where a is a constant that depends on the crystal structure, which implies that ∂R/∂V = 1/(3aR2 ). Then, if the internal energy is given by a pairwise Lennard-Jones (12,6)-potential, eqn 18.31, we can write T,0 = (20.20) where n is the amount of substance in the sample of volume V0. It then follows that K = = = where we have used Vm = V0/n, which is the first of eqn 20.19. Its reciprocal is κ. The typical behaviour of a solid under stress is illustrated in Fig. 20.49. For small strains, the stress–strain relation is a Hooke’s law of force, with the strain directly proportional to the stress. For larger strains, though, dislocations begin to play a major role and the strain becomes plastic in the sense that the sample does not recover its original shape when the stress is removed. The differing rheological characteristics of metals can be traced to the presence of slip planes, which are planes of atoms that under stress may slip or slide relative to one another. The slip planes of a ccp structure are the close-packed planes, and careful inspection of a unit cell shows that there are eight sets of slip planes in different directions. As a result, metals with cubic close-packed structures, like copper, are malleable: they can easily be bent, flattened, or pounded into shape. In contrast, a hexagonal close-packed structure has only one set of slip planes; and metals with hexagonal close packing, like zinc or cadmium, tend to be brittle. 20.9 Electrical properties We shall confine attention to electronic conductivity, but note that some ionic solids display ionic conductivity. Two types of solid are distinguished by the temperature dependence of their electrical conductivity (Fig. 20.50): A metallic conductor is a substance with a conductivity that decreases as the temperature is raised. A semiconductor is a substance with a conductivity that increases as the temperature is raised. A semiconductor generally has a lower conductivity than that typical of metals, but the magnitude of the conductivity is not the criterion of the distinction. It is conventional to classify semiconductors with very low electrical conductivities, such as most synthetic polymers, as insulators. We shall use this term, but it should be appreciated that it is one of convenience rather than one of fundamental significance. A superconductor is a solid that conducts electricity without resistance. (a) The formation of bands The central aspect of solids that determines their electrical properties is the distribution of their electrons. There are two models of this distribution. In one, the nearly 8NAε Vm 8nNAε V0 72nNAε 9aR3 72nNAε R2 0 D E F ∂2 U ∂R2 A B C D E F ∂R ∂V A B C D E F ∂2 U ∂R2 A B C Comment 20.6 To obtain the result in eqn 20.20, we have used the fact that, at equilibrium, R = R0 and σ6 /R0 6 = 1–2, where σ is the scale parameter for the intermolecular potential (r0 in eqn 18.31). Stress Strain Hooke’s law Elastic limit Yield pointTensile strength Fracture Fig. 20.49 At small strains, a body obeys Hooke’s law (stress proportional to strain) and is elastic (recovers its shape when the stress is removed). At high strains, the body is no longer elastic, may yield and become plastic. At even higher strains, the solid fails (at its limiting tensile strength) and finally fractures. 724 20 MATERIALS 2: THE SOLID STATE free-electron approximation, the valence electrons are assumed to be trapped in a box with a periodic potential, with low energy corresponding to the locations of cations. In the tight-binding approximation, the valence electrons are assumed to occupy molecular orbitals delocalized throughout the solid. The latter model is more in accord with the discussion in the foregoing chapters, and we confine our attention to it. We shall consider a one-dimensional solid, which consists of a single, infinitely long line of atoms. At first sight, this model may seem too restrictive and unrealistic. However, not only does it give us the concepts we need to understand conductivity in three-dimensional, macroscopic samples of metals and semiconductors, it is also the starting point for the description of long and thin structures, such as the carbon nanotubes discussed earlier in the chapter. Suppose that each atom has one s orbital available for forming molecular orbitals. We can construct the LCAO-MOs of the solid by adding N atoms in succession to a line, and then infer the electronic structure using the building-up principle. One atom contributes one s orbital at a certain energy (Fig. 20.51). When a second atom is brought up it overlaps the first and forms bonding and antibonding orbitals. The third atom overlaps its nearest neighbour (and only slightly the next-nearest), and from these three atomic orbitals, three molecular orbitals are formed: one is fully bonding, one fully antibonding, and the intermediate orbital is nonbonding between neighbours. The fourth atom leads to the formation of a fourth molecular orbital. At this stage, we can begin to see that the general effect of bringing up successive atoms is to spread the range of energies covered by the molecular orbitals, and also to fill in the range of energies with more and more orbitals (one more for each atom). When N atoms have been added to the line, there are N molecular orbitals covering a band of energies of finite width, and the Hückel secular determinant (Section 11.6) is α − E β 0 0 0 ··· 0 β α − E β 0 0 ··· 0 0 β α − E β 0 ··· 0 0 0 β α − E β ··· 0 = 0 0 0 0 β α − E ··· 0 Ӈ Ӈ Ӈ Ӈ Ӈ ··· Ӈ 0 0 0 0 0 ··· α − E where β is now the (s,s) resonance integral. The theory of determinants applied to such a symmetrical example as this (technically a ‘tridiagonal determinant’) leads to the following expression for the roots: ER = α + 2β cos k = 1, 2, . . . , N (20.21) When N is infinitely large, the difference between neighbouring energy levels (the energies corresponding to k and k + 1) is infinitely small, but, as we show in the following Justification, the band still has finite width overall: EN − E1 → 4β as N → ∞ (20.22) We can think of this band as consisting of N different molecular orbitals, the lowestenergy orbital (k = 1) being fully bonding, and the highest-energy orbital (k = N) being fully antibonding between adjacent atoms (Fig. 20.52). Similar bands form in three-dimensional solids. kπ N + 1 1 10 100 1000 T/K 10-4 10 -8 1 104 10 8 Conductivity/(Scm) -1 Semi- conductor Super- conductor Metal Fig. 20.50 The variation of the electrical conductivity of a substance with temperature is the basis of its classification as a metallic conductor, a semiconductor, or a superconductor. We shall see in Chapter 21 that conductivity is expressed in siemens per metre (S m−1 or, as here, S cm−1 ), where 1 S = 1 Ω−1 (the resistance is expressed in ohms, Ω). N 1= 2 3 4 (a) (b) (c) (d) (e) ¥ Fig. 20.51 The formation of a band of N molecular orbitals by successive addition of N atoms to a line. Note that the band remains of finite width as N becomes infinite and, although it looks continuous, it consists of N different orbitals. 20.9 ELECTRICAL PROPERTIES 725 Highest level of band (fully antibonding)p Highest level of band (fully antibonding)s Lowest level of band (fully bonding)p Lowest level of band (fully bonding)s p s p band s band s,pseparation inatoms Bandgap insolid Fig. 20.52 The overlap of s orbitals gives rise to an s band and the overlap of p orbitals gives rise to a p band. In this case, the s and p orbitals of the atoms are so widely spaced that there is a band gap. In many cases the separation is less and the bands overlap. Energy Fermi level Occupied levels Unoccupied levels Fig. 20.53 When N electrons occupy a band of N orbitals, it is only half full and the electrons near the Fermi level (the top of the filled levels) are mobile. Justification 20.5 The width of a band The energy of the level with k = 1 is E1 = α + 2β cos As N becomes infinite, the cosine term becomes cos 0 = 1. Therefore, in this limit E1 = α + 2β When k has its maximum value of N, EN = α + 2β cos As N approaches infinity, we can ignore the 1 in the denominator, and the cosine term becomes cos π = −1. Therefore, in this limit EN = α − 2β The difference between the upper and lower energies of the band is therefore 4β. The band formed from overlap of s orbitals is called the s band. If the atoms have p orbitals available, the same procedure leads to a p band (as shown in the upper half of Fig. 20.52). If the atomic p orbitals lie higher in energy than the s orbitals, then the p band lies higher than the s band, and there may be a band gap, a range of energies to which no orbital corresponds. However, the s and p bands may also be contiguous or even overlap (as is the case for the 3s and 3p bands in magnesium). (b) The occupation of orbitals Now consider the electronic structure of a solid formed from atoms each able to contribute one electron (for example, the alkali metals). There are N atomic orbitals and therefore N molecular orbitals packed into an apparently continuous band. There are N electrons to accommodate. At T = 0, only the lowest 1 –2N molecular orbitals are occupied (Fig. 20.53), and the HOMO is called the Fermi level. However, unlike in molecules, there are empty orbitals very close in energy to the Fermi level, so it requires hardly any energy to excite the uppermost electrons. Some of the electrons are therefore very mobile and give rise to electrical conductivity. Nπ N + 1 π N + 1 726 20 MATERIALS 2: THE SOLID STATE At temperatures above absolute zero, electrons can be excited by the thermal motion of the atoms. The population, P, of the orbitals is given by the Fermi–Dirac distribution, a version of the Boltzmann distribution that takes into account the effect of the Pauli principle: P = (20.23) The quantity µ is the chemical potential, which in this context is the energy of the level for which P = 1 –2 (note that the chemical potential decreases as the temperature increases). The chemical potential in eqn 20.23 has the dimensions of energy, not energy per mole. The shape of the Fermi–Dirac distribution is shown in Fig. 20.54. For energies well above µ, the 1 in the denominator can be neglected, and then P ≈ e−(E−µ)/kT (20.24) The population now resembles a Boltzmann distribution, decaying exponentially with increasing energy. The higher the temperature, the longer the exponential tail. The electrical conductivity of a metallic solid decreases with increasing temperature even though more electrons are excited into empty orbitals. This apparent paradox is resolved by noting that the increase in temperature causes more vigorous thermal motion of the atoms, so collisions between the moving electrons and an atom are more likely. That is, the electrons are scattered out of their paths through the solid, and are less efficient at transporting charge. (c) Insulators and semiconductors When each atom provides two electrons, the 2N electrons fill the N orbitals of the s band. The Fermi level now lies at the top of the band (at T = 0), and there is a gap before the next band begins (Fig. 20.55). As the temperature is increased, the tail of the Fermi–Dirac distribution extends across the gap, and electrons leave the lower band, which is called the valence band, and populate the empty orbitals of the upper band, which is called the conduction band. As a consequence of electron promotion, positively charged ‘holes’ are left in in the valence band. The holes and promoted electrons are now mobile, and the solid is an electrical conductor. In fact, it is a semiconductor, because the electrical conductivity depends on the number of electrons that are promoted across the gap, and that number increases as the temperature is raised. If the gap is large, though, very few electrons will be promoted at ordinary temperatures and the conductivity will remain close to zero, resulting in an insulator. Thus, the conventional distinction between an insulator and a semiconductor is related to the size of the band gap and is not an absolute distinction like that between a metal (incomplete bands at T = 0) and a semiconductor (full bands at T = 0). Figure 20.55 depicts conduction in an intrinsicsemiconductor, in which semiconduction is a property of the band structure of the pure material. Examples of intrinsic semiconductors include silicon and germanium. A compound semiconductor is an intrinsic semiconductor that is a combination of different elements, such as GaN, CdS, and many d-metal oxides. An extrinsic semiconductor is one in which charge carriers are present as a result of the replacement of some atoms (to the extent of about 1 in 109 ) by dopant atoms, the atoms of another element. If the dopants can trap electrons, they withdraw electrons from the filled band, leaving holes which allow the remaining electrons to move (Fig. 20.56a). This procedure gives rise to p-type semiconductivity, the p indicating that the holes are positive relative to the electrons in the band. An example is silicon doped with indium. We can picture the 1 e(E−µ)/kT + 1 0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 -6 -4 -2 0 2 4 6 ( )/E - P 10 3 1 1/3 1/10T 0= m m Fig. 20.54 The Fermi–Dirac distribution, which gives the population of the levels at a temperature T. The high-energy tail decays exponentially towards zero. The curves are labelled with the value of µ/kT. The pale green region shows the occupation of levels at T = 0. Exploration Express the population P as a function of the variables (E − µ)/µ and µ/kT and then display the set of curves shown in Fig. 20.54 as a single surface. 20.9 ELECTRICAL PROPERTIES 727 semiconduction as arising from the transfer of an electron from a Si atom to a neighbouring In atom. The electrons at the top of the silicon valence band are now mobile, and carry current through the solid. Alternatively, a dopant might carry excess electrons (for example, phosphorus atoms introduced into germanium), and these additional electrons occupy otherwise empty bands, giving n-type semiconductivity, where n denotes the negative charge of the carriers (Fig. 20.56b). The preparation of doped but otherwise ultrapure materials was described in Impact I6.2. Now we consider the properties of a p–n junction, the interface of a p-type and ntype semiconductor. Consider the application of a ‘reverse bias’ to the junction, in the sense that a negative electrode is attached to the p-type semiconductor and a positive electrode is attached to the n-type semiconductor (Fig. 20.57a). Under these conditions, the positively charged holes in p-type semicondutor are attracted to the negative electrode and the negatively charged electrons in the n-type semiconductor are attracted to the positive electrode. As a consequence, charge does not flow across the junction. Now consider the application of a ‘forward bias’ to the junction, in the sense that the positive electrode is attached to the p-type semiconductor and the negative electrode is attached to the n-type semiconductor (Fig. 20.57b). Now charge flows across the junction, with electrons in the n-type semiconductor moving toward the positive electrode and holes moving in the opposite direction. It follows that a p–n junction affords a great deal of control over the magnitude and direction of current Energy Acceptor band Donor band (a) (b) Energy (a) 0T = (b) 0T > Conduction band Valence band Band gap, gE Thermal excitation Fig. 20.55 (a) When 2N electrons are present, the band is full and the material is an insulator at T = 0. (b) At temperatures above T = 0, electrons populate the levels of the upper conduction band and the solid is a semiconductor. Fig. 20.56 (a) A dopant with fewer electrons than its host can form a narrow band that accepts electrons from the valence band. The holes in the band are mobile and the substance is a p-type semiconductor. (b) A dopant with more electrons than its host forms a narrow band that can supply electrons to the conduction band. The electrons it supplies are mobile and the substance is an n-type semiconductor. + - +n p Electron Hole (a) (b) Fig. 20.57 A p–n junction under (a) reverse bias, (b) forward bias. 728 20 MATERIALS 2: THE SOLID STATE through a material. This control is essential for the operation of transistors and diodes, which are key components of modern electronic devices. As electrons and holes move across a p–n junction under forward bias, they recombine and release energy. However, as long as the forward bias continues to be applied, the flow of charge from the electrodes to the semiconductors will replenish them with electrons and holes, so the junction will sustain a current. In some solids, the energy of electron–hole recombination is released as heat and the device becomes warm. This is the case for silicon semiconductors, and is one reason why computers need efficient cooling systems. IMPACT ON NANOSCIENCE I20.2 Nanowires We have already remarked (Impacts I9.1, I9.2, and I19.3) that research on nanometre-sized materials is motivated by the possibility that they will form the basis for cheaper and smaller electronic devices. The synthesis of nanowires, nanometre-sized atomic assemblies that conduct electricity, is a major step in the fabrication of nanodevices. An important type of nanowire is based on carbon nanotubes, which, like graphite, can conduct electrons through delocalized π molecular orbitals that form from unhybridized 2p orbitals on carbon. Recent studies have shown a correlation between structure and conductivity in single-walled nanotubes (SWNTs) that does not occur in graphite. The SWNT in Fig. 20.45 is a semiconductor. If the hexagons are rotated by 90° about their sixfold axis, the resulting SWNT is a metallic conductor. Carbon nanotubes are promising building blocks not only because they have useful electrical properties but also because they have unusual mechanical properties. For example, an SWNT has a Young’s modulus that is approximately five times larger and a tensile strength that is approximately 375 times larger than that of steel. Silicon nanowires can be made by focusing a pulsed laser beam on to a solid target composed of silicon and iron. The laser ejects Fe and Si atoms from the surface of the target, forming a vapour that can condense into liquid FeSin nanoclusters at sufficiently low temperatures. The phase diagram for this complex mixture shows that solid silicon and liquid FeSin coexist at temperatures higher than 1473 K. Hence, it is possible to precipitate solid silicon from the mixture if the experimental conditions are controlled to maintain the FeSin nanoclusters in a liquid state that is supersaturated with silicon. It is observed that the silicon precipitate consists of nanowires with diameters of about 10 nm and lengths greater than 1 µm. Nanowires are also fabricated by molecular beam epitaxy (MBE), in which gaseous atoms or molecules are sprayed onto a crystalline surface in an ultra-high vacuum chamber. The result is formation of highly ordered structures. Through careful control of the chamber temperature and of the spraying process, it is possible to deposit thin films on to a surface or to create nanometre-sized assemblies with specific shapes. For example, Fig. 20.58 shows an AFM image of germanium nanowires on a silicon surface. The wires are about 2 nm high, 10–32 nm wide, and 10–600 nm long. Direct manipulation of atoms on a surface also leads to the formation of nanowires. The Coulomb attraction between an atom and the tip of an STM can be exploited to move atoms along a surface, arranging them into patterns, such as wires. 20.10 Optical properties In this section, we explore the consequences of interactions between electromagnetic radiation and solids. Our focus will be on the origins of phenomena that inform the design of useful devices, such as lasers and light-emitting diodes. Fig. 20.58 Germanium nanowires fabricated on to a silicon surface by molecular beam epitaxy. (Reproduced with permission from T. Ogino et al. Acc. Chem. Res. 32, 447 (1999).) 20.10 OPTICAL PROPERTIES 729 Fig. 20.59 The electron–hole pair shown on the left can migrate through a solid lattice as the excitation hops from molecule to molecule. The mobile excitation is called an exciton. n(a) (b) n Fig. 20.60 (a) The alignment of transition dipoles (the yellow arrows) is energetically unfavourable, and the exciton absorption is shifted to higher energy (higher frequency). (b) The alignment is energetically favourable for a transition in this orientation, and the exciton band occurs at lower frequency than in the isolated molecules. r qm1 m2 (a) Light absorption by molecular solids, metallic conductors, and semiconductors From the discussion in earlier chapters, we are already familiar with the factors that determine the energy and intensity of light absorbed by atoms and molecules in the gas phase and in solution. Now we consider the effects on the electronic absorption spectrum of bringing atoms or molecules together into a solid. Consider an electronic excitation of a molecule (or an ion) in a crystal. If the excitation corresponds to the removal of an electron from one orbital of a molecule and its elevation to an orbital of higher energy, then the excited state of the molecule can be envisaged as the coexistence of an electron and a hole. This electron–hole pair, the particle-like exciton, migrates from molecule to molecule in the crystal (Fig. 20.59). Exciton formation causes spectral lines to shift, split, and change intensity. The electron and the hole jump together from molecule to molecule as they migrate. A migrating excitation of this kind is called a Frenkel exciton. The electron and hole can also be on different molecules, but in each other’s vicinity. A migrating excitation of this kind, which is now spread over several molecules (more usually ions), is a Wannier exciton. Frenkel excitons are more common in molecular solids. Their migration implies that there is an interaction between the species that constitute the crystal, for otherwise the excitation on one unit could not move to another. This interaction affects the energy levels of the system. The strength of the interaction governs the rate at which an exciton moves through the crystal: a strong interaction results in fast migration, and a vanishingly small interaction leaves the exciton localized on its original molecule. The specific mechanism of interaction that leads to exciton migration is the interaction between the transition dipole moments of the excitation. Thus, an electric dipole transition in a molecule is accompanied by a shift of charge, and the transient dipole exerts a force on an adjacent molecule. The latter responds by shifting its charge. This process continues and the excitation migrates through the crystal. The energy shift arising from the interaction between transition dipoles can be understood in terms of their electrostatic interaction. An all-parallel arrangement of the dipoles (Fig. 20.60a) is energetically unfavourable, so the absorption occurs at a higher frequency than in the isolated molecule. Conversely, a head-to-tail alignment of transient dipoles (Fig. 20.60b) is energetically favourable, and the transition occurs at a lower frequency than in the isolated molecules. Illustration 20.1 Predicting the frequency of exciton absorption in a molecular solid Recall from Section 18.4 that the potential energy of interaction between two parallel dipoles µ1 and µ2 separated by a distance r is V = µ1µ2(1 − 3 cos2 θ)/4πε0r3 , where the angle θ is defined in (1). We see that θ = 0° for a head-to-tail alignment and θ = 90° for a parallel alignment. It follows that V < 0 (an attractive interaction) for 0° ≤ θ < 54.74°, V = 0 when θ = 54.74° (for then 1 − 3 cos2 θ = 0), and V > 0 (a repulsive interaction) for 54.74° < θ ≤ 90°. This result is expected on the basis of qualitative arguments. In a head-to-tail arrangement, the interaction between the region of partial positive charge in one molecule with the region of partial negative charge in the other molecule is attractive. By contrast, in a parallel arrangement, the molecular interaction is repulsive because of the close approach of regions of partial charge with the same sign. It follows from this discussion that, when 0° ≤ θ < 54.74°, the frequency of exciton absorption is lower than the corresponding absorption frequency for the isolated molecule (a red shift in the spectrum of the solid with respect to that of the isolated 730 20 MATERIALS 2: THE SOLID STATE (b) (a) (a)(b) Davydov splitting n Fig. 20.61 When the transition moments within a unit cell may lie in different relative directions, as depicted in (a) and (b), the energies of the transitions are shifted and give rise to the two bands labelled (a) and (b) in the spectrum. The separation of the bands is the Davydov splitting. molecule). Conversely, when 54.74° < θ ≤ 90°, the frequency of exciton absorption is higher than the corresponding absorption frequency for the isolated molecule (a blue shift in the spectrum of the solid with respect to that of the isolated molecule). In the special case θ = 54.74° the solid and the isolated molecule have absorption lines at the same frequency. If there are N molecules per unit cell, there are N exciton bands in the spectrum (if all of them are allowed). The splitting between the bands is the Davydov splitting. To understand the origin of the splitting, consider the case N = 2 with the molecules arranged as in Fig. 20.61. Let the transition dipoles be along the length of the molecules. The radiation stimulates the collective excitation of the transition dipoles that are inphase between neighbouring unit cells. Within each unit cell the transition dipoles may be arrayed in the two different ways shown in the illustration. Since the two orientations correspond to different interaction energies, with interaction being repulsive in one and attractive in the other, the two transitions appear in the spectrum at two bands of different frequencies. The Davydov splitting is determined by the energy of interaction between the transition dipoles within the unit cell. Now we turn our attention to metallic conductors and semiconductors. Again we need to consider the consequences of interactions between particles, in this case atoms, which are now so strong that we need to abandon arguments based primarily on van der Waals interactions in favour of a full molecular orbital treatment, the band model of Section 20.9. Consider Fig. 20.53, which shows bands in an idealized metallic conductor. The absorption of light can excite electrons from the occupied levels to the unoccupied levels. There is a near continuum of unoccupied energy levels above the Fermi level, so we expect to observe absorption over a wide range of frequencies. In metals, the bands are sufficiently wide that radiation from the radiofrequency to the middle of the ultraviolet region of the electromagnetic spectrum is absorbed (metals are transparent to very high-frequency radiation, such as X-rays and γ-rays). Because this range of absorbed frequencies includes the entire visible spectrum, we expect that all metals should appear black. However, we know that metals are shiny (that is, they reflect light) and some are coloured (that is, they absorb light of only certain wavelengths), so we need to extend our model. To explain the shiny appearance of a smooth metal surface, we need to realize that the absorbed energy can be re-emitted very efficiently as light, with only a small fraction of the energy being released to the surroundings as heat. Because the atoms near the surface of the material absorb most of the radiation, emission also occurs primarily from the surface. In essence, if the sample is excited with visible light, then visible light will be reflected from the surface, accounting for the lustre of the material. The perceived colour of a metal depends on the frequency range of reflected light which, in turn, depends on the frequency range of light that can be absorbed and, by extension, on the band structure. Silver reflects light with nearly equal efficiency across the visible spectrum because its band structure has many unoccupied energy levels that can be populated by absorption of, and depopulated by emission of, visible light. On the other hand, copper has its characteristic colour because it has relatively fewer unoccupied energy levels that can be excited with violet, blue, and green light. The material reflects at all wavelengths, but more light is emitted at lower frequencies (corresponding to yellow, orange, and red) Similar arguments account for the colours of other metals, such as the yellow of gold. Finally, consider semiconductors. We have already seen that promotion of electrons from the valence to the conduction band of a semiconductor can be the result of 20.10 OPTICAL PROPERTIES 731 4 F Pump 4 I 1.06 mm Thermal decay Fig. 20.62 The transitions involved in a neodymium laser. The laser action takes place between the 4 F and 4 I excited states. 2 E 2 T2 Pump Fig. 20.63 The transitions involved in a titanium sapphire laser. The laser medium consists of sapphire (Al2O3) doped with Ti3+ ions. Monochromatic light from a pump laser induces a 2 E ← 2 T2 transition in a Ti3+ ion that resides in a site with octahedral symmetry. After radiationless vibrational excitation in the 2 E state, laser emission occurs from a very large number of closely spaced vibronic states of the medium. As a result, the titanium sapphire laser emits radiation over a broad spectrum that spans from about 700 nm to about 1000 nm. thermal excitation, if the band gap Eg is comparable to the energy that can be supplied by heating. In some materials, the band gap is very large and electron promotion can occur only by excitation with electromagnetic radiation. However, we see from Fig. 20.55 that there is a frequency νmin = Eg/h below which light absorption cannot occur. Above this frequency threshold, a wide range of frequencies can be absorbed by the material, as in a metal. Illustration 20.2 Predicting the colour of a semiconductor The semiconductor cadmium sulfide (CdS) has a band gap energy of 2.4 eV (equivalent to 3.8 × 10−19 J). It follows that the minimum electronic absorption frequency is νmin = = 5.8 × 1014 s−1 This frequency, of 5.8 × 1014 Hz, corresponds to a wavelength of 517 nm (green light; see Table 14.1). Lower frequencies, corresponding to yellow, orange, and red, are not absorbed and consequently CdS appears yellow-orange. Self-test 20.7 Predict the colours of the following materials, given their band-gap energies (in parentheses): GaAs (1.43 eV), HgS (2.1 eV), and ZnS (3.6 eV). [Black, red, and colourless] (b) Light emission by solid-state lasers and light-emitting diodes Here we explore the further consequences of light emission in solids, focusing our attention on ionic crystals and semiconductors used in the design of lasers and lightemitting diodes. In Chapter 14 we discussed the conditions under which a material can become a laser and it would be helpful to review those concepts. The neodymium laser is an example of a four-level laser, in which the laser transition terminates in a state other than the ground state of the laser material (Fig. 20.62). In one form it consists of Nd3+ ions at low concentration in yttrium aluminium garnet (YAG, specifically Y3Al5O12), and is then known as a Nd–YAG laser. The population inversion results from pumping a majority of the Nd3+ ions into an excited state by using an intense flash from another source, followed by a radiationless transition to another excited state. The pumping flash need not be monochromatic because the upper level actually consists of several states spanning a band of frequencies. A neodymium laser operates at a number of wavelengths in the infrared, the band at 1064 nm being most common. The transition at 1064 nm is very efficient and the laser is capable of substantial power output, either in continuous or pulsed (by Q-switching or mode-locking as discussed in Section 14.5) modes of operation. The titanium sapphire laser consists of Ti3+ ions at low concentration in a crystal of sapphire (Al2O3). The electronic absorption spectrum of Ti3+ ion in sapphire is very similar to that shown in Fig. 14.13, with a broad absorption band centred at around 500 nm that arises from vibronically allowed d–d transitions of the Ti3+ ion in an octahedral environment provided by oxygen atoms of the host lattice. As a result, the emission spectrum of Ti3+ in sapphire is also broad and laser action occurs over a wide range of wavelengths (Fig. 20.63). Therefore, the titanium sapphire laser is an example of a vibronic laser, in which the laser transitions originate from vibronic transitions in the laser medium. The titanium sapphire laser is usually pumped by another laser, such as a Nd–YAG laser or an argon-ion laser (Further information 14.1), 3.8 × 10−19 J 6.626 × 10−34 J 732 20 MATERIALS 2: THE SOLID STATE and can be operated in either a continuous or pulsed fashion. Mode-locked titanium sapphire lasers produce energetic (20 mJ to 1 J) and very short (20–100 fs, 1 fs = 10−15 s) pulses. When considered together with broad wavelength tunability (700–1000 nm), these features of the titanium sapphire laser justify its wide use in modern spectroscopy and photochemistry. The unique electrical properties of p–n junctions between semiconductors can be put to good use in optical devices. In some materials, most notably gallium arsenide, GaAs, energy from electron–hole recombination is released not as heat but is carried away by photons as electrons move across the junction under forward bias. Practical light-emitting diodes of this kind are widely used in electronic displays. The wave- lengthofemittedlightdependsonthebandgapofthesemiconductor.Galliumarsenide itself emits infrared light, but the band gap is widened by incorporating phosphorus, and a material of composition approximately GaAs0.6P0.4 emits light in the red region of the spectrum. A light-emitting diode is not a laser, because no resonance cavity and stimulated emission are involved. In diode lasers, light emission due to electron–hole recombination is employed as the basis of laser action. The population inversion can be sustained by sweeping away the electrons that fall into the holes of the p-type semiconductor, and a resonant cavity can be formed by using the high refractive index of the semiconducting material and cleaving single crystals so that the light is trapped by the abrupt variation of refractive index. One widely used material is Ga1−xAlxAs, which produces infrared laser radiation and is widely used in compact-disc (CD) players. High-power diode lasers are also used to pump other lasers. One example is the pumping of Nd:YAG lasers by Ga0.91Al0.09As/Ga0.7Al0.3As diode lasers. The Nd:YAG laser is often used to pump yet another laser, such as a Ti:sapphire laser. As a result, it is now possible to construct a laser system for steady-state or time-resolved spectroscopy entirely out of solid-state components. (c) Nonlinear optical phenomena Nonlinear optical phenomena arise from changes in the optical properties of a material in the presence of an intense electric field from electromagnetic radiation. Here we explore two phenomena that not only can be studied conveniently with intense laser beams but are commonly used in the laboratory to modify the output of lasers for specific experiments, such as those described in Section 14.6. In frequency doubling, or second harmonic generation, an intense laser beam is converted to radiation with twice (and in general a multiple) of its initial frequency as it passes though a suitable material. It follows that frequency doubling and tripling of a Nd–YAG laser, which emits radiation at 1064 nm, produce green light at 532 nm and ultraviolet radiation at 355 nm, respectively. We can account for frequency doubling by examining how a substance responds nonlinearly to incident radiation of frequency ω = 2πν. Radiation of a particular frequency arises from oscillations of an electric dipole at that frequency and the incident electric field E induces an electric dipole of magnitude µ, in the substance. At low light intensity, most materials respond linearly, in the sense that µ = αE, where α is the polarizability (see Section 18.2). To allow for nonlinear response by some materials at high light intensity, we can write µ = αE + 1 –2βE2 + . . . (20.25) where the coefficient β is the hyperpolarizability of the material. The nonlinear term βE2 can be expanded as follows if we suppose that the incident electric field is E0 cos ωt: βE2 = βE2 0 cos2 ωt = 1 –2βE2 0(1 + cos 2ωt) (20.26) Comment 20.7 The refractive index, nr, of the medium, the ratio of the speed of light in a vacuum, c, to its speed c′ in the medium: nr = c/c′. A beam of light changes direction (‘bends’) when it passes from a region of one refractive index to a region with a different refractive index. See Appendix 3 for details. 20.11 MAGNETIC PROPERTIES 733 Hence, the nonlinear term contributes an induced electric dipole that oscillates at the frequency 2ω and that can act as a source of radiation of that frequency. Common materials that can be used for frequency doubling in laser systems include crystals of potassium dihydrogenphosphate (KH2PO4), lithium niobate (LiNbO3), and βbarium borate (β-BaB2O4). Another important nonlinear optical phenomenon is the opticalKerreffect, which arises from a change in refractive index of a well chosen medium, the Kerr medium, when it is exposed to intense laser pulses. Because a beam of light changes direction when it passes from a region of one refractive index to a region with a different refractive index, changes in refractive index result in the self-focusing of an intense laser pulse as it travels through the Kerr medium (Fig. 20.64). The optical Kerr effect is used as a mechanism of mode-locking lasers (Section 14.5). A Kerr medium is included in the cavity and next to it is a small aperture. The procedure makes use of the fact that the gain, the growth in intensity, of a frequency component of the radiation in the cavity is very sensitive to amplification and, once a particular frequency begins to grow, it can quickly dominate. When the power inside the cavity is low, a portion of the photons will be blocked by the aperture, creating a significant loss. A spontaneous fluctuation in intensity—a bunching of photons— may begin to turn on the optical Kerr effect and the changes in the refractive index of the Kerr medium will result in a Kerrlens, which is the self-focusing of the laser beam. The bunch of photons can pass through and travel to the far end of the cavity, amplifying as it goes. The Kerr lens immediately disappears (if the medium is well chosen), but is re-created when the intense pulse returns from the mirror at the far end. In this way, that particular bunch of photons may grow to considerable intensity because it alone is stimulating emission in the cavity. Sapphire is an example of a Kerr medium that facilitates the mode locking of titanium sapphire lasers, resulting in very short laser pulses of duration in the femtosecond range. In addition to being useful laboratory tools, nonlinear optical materials are also finding many applications in the telecommunications industry, which is becoming ever more reliant on optical signals transmitted through optical fibres to carry voice and data. Judicious use of nonlinear phenomena leads to more ways in which the properties of optical signals, and hence the information they carry, can be manipulated. 20.11 Magnetic properties The magnetic properties of metallic solids and semiconductors depend strongly on the band structures of the material (see Further reading). Here we confine our attention largely to magnetic properties that stem from collections of individual molecules or ions such as d-metal complexes. Much of the discussion applies to liquid and gas phase samples as well as to solids. (a) Magnetic susceptibility The magnetic and electric properties of molecules and solids are analogous. For instance, some molecules possess permanent magnetic dipole moments, and an applied magnetic field can induce a magnetic moment, with the result that the entire solid sample becomes magnetized. The analogue of the electric polarization, P, is the magnetization, M, the average molecular magnetic dipole moment multiplied by the number density of molecules in the sample. The magnetization induced by a field of strength H is proportional to H, and we write M = χH [20.27] Kerr medium Laser beam Aperture Fig. 20.64 An illustration of the Kerr effect. An intense laser beam is focused inside a Kerr medium and passes through a small aperture in the laser cavity. This effect may be used to mode-lock a laser, as explained in the text. 734 20 MATERIALS 2: THE SOLID STATE where χ is the dimensionless volume magnetic susceptibility. A closely related quantity is the molar magnetic susceptibility, χm: χm = χVm [20.28] where Vm is the molar volume of the substance (we shall soon see why it is sensible to introduce this quantity). The magnetic flux density, B, is related to the applied field strength and the magnetization by B = µ0(H + M) = µ0(1 + χ)H [20.29] where µ0 is the vacuum permeability, µ0 = 4π × 10−7 J C−2 m−1 s2 . The magnetic flux density can be thought of as the density of magnetic lines of force permeating the medium. This density is increased if M adds to H (when χ > 0), but the density is decreased if M opposes H (when χ < 0). Materials for which χ is positive are called paramagnetic. Those for which χ is negative are called diamagnetic. Just as polar molecules in fluid phases contribute a term proportional to µ2 /3kT to the electric polarization of a medium (eqn 18.15), so molecules with a permanent magnetic dipole moment of magnitude m contribute to the magnetization an amount proportional to m2 /3kT. However, unlike for polar molecules, this contribution to the magnetization is obtained even for paramagnetic species trapped in solids, because the direction of the spin of the electrons is typically not coupled to the orientation of the molecular framework and so contributes even when the nuclei are stationary. An applied field can also induce a magnetic moment by stirring up currents in the electron distribution like those responsible for the chemical shift in NMR (Section 15.5). The constant of proportionality between the induced moment and the applied field is called the magnetizability, ξ (xi), and the magnetic analogue of eqn 18.15 is χ = Nµ0 ξ + (20.30) We can now see why it is convenient to introduce χm, because the product of the number density N and the molar volume is Avogadro’s constant, NA: NVm = = = NA (20.31) Hence χm = NAµ0 ξ + (20.32) and the density dependence of the susceptibility (which occurs in eqn 20.30 via N = NAρ/M) has been eliminated. The expression for χm is in agreement with the empirical Curie law: χm = A + (20.33) with A = NAµ0ξ and C = NAµ0m2 /3k. As indicated above, and in contrast to electric moments, this expression applies to solids as well as fluid phases. The magnetic susceptibility is traditionally measured with a Gouy balance. This instrument consists of a sensitive balance from which the sample hangs in the form of a narrow cylinder and lies between the poles of a magnet. If the sample is paramagnetic, it is drawn into the field, and its apparent weight is greater than when the field is off. A diamagnetic sample tends to be expelled from the field and appears to weigh less when the field is turned on. The balance is normally calibrated against a sample of C T D F m2 3kT A C nNAVm nVm NVm V D F m2 3kT A C 20.11 MAGNETIC PROPERTIES 735 SQUID Superconducting wire Current Current Magnetic field Sample Fig. 20.65 The arrangement used to magnetic susceptibility with a SQUID. The sample is moved upwards in small increments and the potential difference across the SQUID is measured. Synoptic table 20.6* Magnetic susceptibilities at 298 K c/10−6 cm/(10−5 cm3 mol−1 ) H2O(l) −9.06 −160 NaCl(s) −13.9 −38 Cu(s) −9.6 −6.8 CuSO4·5H2O(s) +176 +1930 * More values are given in the Data section. known susceptibility. The modern version of the determination makes use of a superconducting quantum interference device (SQUID, Fig. 20.65). A SQUID takes advantage of the quantization of magnetic flux and the property of current loops in superconductors that, as part of the circuit, include a weakly conducting link through which electrons must tunnel. The current that flows in the loop in a magnetic field depends on the value of the magnetic flux, and a SQUID can be exploited as a very sensitive magnetometer. Table 20.6 lists some experimental values. A typical paramagnetic volume susceptibility is about 10−3 , and a typical diamagnetic volume susceptibility is about (−)10−5 . The permanent magnetic moment can be extracted from susceptibility measurements by plotting χ against 1/T. (b) The permanent magnetic moment The permanent magnetic moment of a molecule arises from any unpaired electron spins in the molecule. We saw in Section 10.8 that the magnitude of the magnetic moment of an electron is proportional to the magnitude of the spin angular momentum, {s(s + 1)}1/2 $. µ = ge{s(s + 1)}1/2 µB µB = (20.34) where ge = 2.0023 (see Section 15.1). If there are several electron spins in each molecule, they combine to a total spin S, and then s(s + 1) should be replaced by S(S + 1). It follows that the spin contribution to the molar magnetic susceptibility is χm = (20.35) This expression shows that the susceptibility is positive, so the spin magnetic moments contribute to the paramagnetic susceptibilities of materials. The contribution decreases with increasing temperature because the thermal motion randomizes the spin orientations. In practice, a contribution to the paramagnetism also arises from the orbital angular momenta of electrons: we have discussed the spin-only contribution. Illustration 20.3 Calculating a magnetic susceptibility Consider a complex salt with three unpaired electrons per complex cation at 298 K, of mass density 3.24 g cm−3 , and molar mass 200 g mol−1 . First note that = 6.3001 × 10−6 m3 K−1 mol−1 NAg2 e µ0µ2 B 3k NAg2 eµ0µ2 BS(S + 1) 3kT e$ 2me 736 20 MATERIALS 2: THE SOLID STATE (a) (b) (c) Fig. 20.66 (a) In a paramagnetic material, the electron spins are aligned at random in the absence of an applied magnetic field. (b) In a ferromagnetic material, the electron spins are locked into a parallel alignment over large domains. (c) In an antiferromagnetic material, the electron spins are locked into an antiparallel arrangement. The latter two arrangements survive even in the absence of an applied field. Consequently, χm = 6.3001 × 10−6 × m3 mol−1 Substitution of the data with S = 3 –2 gives χm = 7.9 × 10−8 m3 mol−1 . Note that the density is not needed at this stage. To obtain the volume magnetic susceptibility, the molar susceptibility is divided by the molar volume Vm = M/ρ, where ρ is the mass density. In this illustration, Vm = 61.7 cm3 mol−1 , so χ = 1.3 × 10−3 . At low temperatures, some paramagnetic solids make a phase transition to a state in which large domains of spins align with parallel orientations. This cooperative align- mentgivesrisetoaverystrongmagnetizationandiscalledferromagnetism(Fig.20.66). In other cases, the cooperative effect leads to alternating spin orientations: the spins are locked into a low-magnetization arrangement to give an antiferromagnetic phase. The ferromagnetic phase has a nonzero magnetization in the absence of an applied field, but the antiferromagnetic phase has a zero magnetization because the spin magnetic moments cancel. The ferromagnetic transition occurs at the Curietemperature, and the antiferromagnetic transition occurs at the Néel temperature. (c) Induced magnetic moments An applied magnetic field induces the circulation of electronic currents. These currents give rise to a magnetic field that usually opposes the applied field, so the substance is diamagnetic. In a few cases the induced field augments the applied field, and the substance is then paramagnetic. The great majority of molecules with no unpaired electron spins are diamagnetic. In these cases, the induced electron currents occur within the orbitals of the molecule that are occupied in its ground state. In the few cases in which molecules are paramagnetic despite having no unpaired electrons, the induced electron currents flow in the opposite direction because they can make use of unoccupied orbitals that lie close to the HOMO in energy. This orbital paramagnetism can be distinguished from spin paramagnetism by the fact that it is temperature independent: this is why it is called temperature-independent paramagnetism (TIP). We can summarize these remarks as follows. All molecules have a diamagnetic component to their susceptibility, but it is dominated by spin paramagnetism if the molecules have unpaired electrons. In a few cases (where there are low-lying excited states) TIP is strong enough to make the molecules paramagnetic even though their electrons are paired. 20.12 Superconductors The resistance to flow of electrical current of a normal metallic conductor decreases smoothly with temperature but never vanishes. However, certain solids known as superconductors conduct electricity without resistance below a critical temperature, Tc. Following the discovery in 1911 that mercury is a superconductor below 4.2 K, the boiling point of liquid helium, physicists and chemists made slow but steady progress in the discovery of superconductors with higher values of Tc. Metals, such as tungsten, mercury, and lead, tend to have Tc values below about 10 K. Intermetallic compounds, such as Nb3X (X = Sn, Al, or Ge), and alloys, such as Nb/Ti and Nb/Zr, have intermediate Tc values ranging between 10 K and 23 K. In 1986, high-temperature superconductors (HTSC) were discovered. Several ceramics, inorganic powders that have S(S + 1) T/K 20.12 SUPERCONDUCTORS 737 been fused and hardened by heating to a high temperature, containing oxocuprate motifs, CumOn, are now known with Tc values well above 77 K, the boiling point of the inexpensive refrigerant liquid nitrogen. For example, HgBa2Ca2Cu2O8 has Tc = 153 K. Superconductors have unique magnetic properties as well. Some superconductors, classed as Type I, show abrupt loss of superconductivity when an applied magnetic field exceeds a critical value Hc characteristic of the material. It is observed that the value of Hc depends on temperature and Tc as Hc(T) = Hc(0) 1 − (20.36) where Hc(0) is the value of Hc as T → 0. Type I superconductors are also completely diamagnetic below Hc, meaning that no magnetic field lines penetrate into the material. This complete exclusion of a magnetic field in a material is known as the Meissner effect, which can be visualized by the levitation of a superconductor above a magnet. Type II superconductors, which include the HTSCs, show a gradual loss of superconductivity and diamagnetism with increasing magnetic field. There is a degree of periodicity in the elements that exhibit superconductivity. The metals iron, cobalt, nickel, copper, silver, and gold do not display superconductivity, nor do the alkali metals. It is observed that, for simple metals, ferromagnetism and superconductivity never coexist, but in some of the oxocuprate superconductors ferromagnetism and superconductivity can coexist. One of the most widely studied oxocuprate superconductors YBa2Cu3O7 (informally known as ‘123’ on account of the proportions of the metal atoms in the compound) has the structure shown in Fig. 20.67. The square-pyramidal CuO5 units arranged as two-dimensional layers and the square planar CuO4 units arranged in sheets are common structural features of oxocuprate HTSCs. The mechanism of superconduction is well-understood for low-temperature materials but there is as yet no settled explanation of high-temperature superconductivity. The central concept of low-temperature superconduction is the existence of a Cooper pair, a pair of electrons that exists on account of the indirect electron–electron interactions fostered by the nuclei of the atoms in the lattice. Thus, if one electron is in a particular region of a solid, the nuclei there move toward it to give a distorted local structure (Fig. 20.68). Because that local distortion is rich in positive charge, it is favourable for a second electron to join the first. Hence, there is a virtual attraction between the two electrons, and they move together as a pair. The local distortion can be easily disrupted by thermal motion of the ions in the solid, so the virtual attraction D F T2 T2 c A C Cu Ba Y O (a) (b) Fig. 20.67 Structure of the YBa2Cu3O7 superconductor. (a) Metal atom positions. (b) The polyhedra show the positions of oxygen atoms and indicate that the metal ions are in square-planar and squarepyramidal coordination environments. e Fig. 20.68 The formation of a Cooper pair. One electron distorts the crystal lattice and the second electron has a lower energy if it goes to that region. These electron–lattice interactions effectively bind the two electrons into a pair. 738 20 MATERIALS 2: THE SOLID STATE occurs only at very low temperatures. A Cooper pair undergoes less scattering than an individual electron as it travels through the solid because the distortion caused by one electron can attract back the other electron should it be scattered out of its path in a collision. Because the Cooper pair is stable against scattering, it can carry charge freely through the solid, and hence give rise to superconduction. The Cooper pairs responsible for low-temperature superconductivity are likely to be important in HTSCs, but the mechanism for pairing is hotly debated. There is evidence implicating the arrangement of CuO5 layers and CuO4 sheets in the mechanism of high-temperature superconduction. It is believed that movement of electrons along the linked CuO4 units accounts for superconductivity, whereas the linked CuO5 units act as ‘charge reservoirs’ that maintain an appropriate number of electrons in the superconducting layers. Superconductors can sustain large currents and, consequently, are excellent materials for the high-field magnets used in modern NMR spectroscopy (Chapter 15). However, the potential uses of superconducting materials are not limited to the field to chemical instrumentation. For example, HTSCs with Tc values near ambient temperature would be very efficient components of an electrical power transmission system, in which energy loss due to electrical resistance would be minimized. The appropriate technology is not yet available, but research in this area of materials science is active. Checklist of key ideas 1. Solids are classified as metallic, ionic, covalent, and molecular. 2. A space lattice is the pattern formed by points representing the locations of structural motifs (atoms, molecules, or groups of atoms, molecules, or ions). The Bravais lattices are the 14 distinct space lattices in three dimensions (Fig. 20.8). 3. A unit cell is an imaginary parallelepiped that contains one unit of a translationally repeating pattern. Unit cells are classified into seven crystal systems according to their rotational symmetries. 4. Crystal planes are specified by a set of Miller indices (hkl) and the separation of neighbouring planes in a rectangular lattice is given by 1/d2 hkl = h2 /a2 + k2 /b2 + l2 /c2 . 5. Bragg’s law relating the glancing angle θ to the separation of lattice planes is λ = 2d sin θ, where λ is the wavelength of the radiation. 6. The scattering factor is a measure of the ability of an atom to diffract radiation (eqn 20.6). 7. The structure factor is the overall amplitude of a wave diffracted by the {hkl} planes (eqn 20.7). Fourier synthesis is the construction of the electron density distribution from structure factors (eqn 20.8). 8. A Patterson synthesis is a map of interatomic vectors obtained by Fourier analysis of diffraction intensities (eqn 20.9). 9. Structure refinement is the adjustment of structural parameters to give the best fit between the observed intensities and those calculated from the model of the structure deduced from the diffraction pattern. 10. Many elemental metals have close-packed structures with coordination number 12; close-packed structures may be either cubic (ccp) or hexagonal (hcp). 11. Representative ionic structures include the caesium-chloride, rock-salt, and zinc-blende structures. 12. The radius-ratio rule may be used cautiously to predict which of these three structures is likely (eqn 20.12). 13. The lattice enthalpy is the change in enthalpy (per mole of formula units) accompanying the complete separation of the components of the solid. The electrostatic contribution to the lattice enthalpy is expressed by the Born–Mayer equation (eqn 20.15). 14. A covalent network solid is a solid in which covalent bonds in a definite spatial orientation link the atoms in a network extending through the crystal. A molecular solid is a solid consisting of discrete molecules held together by van der Waals interactions. 15. The mechanical properties of a solid are discussed in terms of the relationship between stress, the applied force divided by the area to which it is applied, and strain, the distortion of a sample resulting from an applied stress. 16. The response of a solid to an applied stress is summarized by the Young’s modulus (eqn 20.16a), the bulk modulus (eqn 20.16b), the shear modulus (eqn 20.16c), and Poisson’s ratio (eqn 20.17). 17. Electronic conductors are classified as metallic conductors or semiconductors according to the temperature dependence of their conductivities. An insulator is a semiconductor with a very low electrical conductivity. DISCUSSION QUESTIONS 739 18. According to the band theory, electrons occupy molecular orbitals formed from the overlap of atomic orbitals: full bands are called valence bands and empty bands are called conduction bands. The occupation of the orbitals in a solid is given by the Fermi–Dirac distribution (eqn 20.23). 19. Semiconductors are classified as p-type or n-type according to whether conduction is due to holes in the valence band or electrons in the conduction band. 20. The spectroscopic properties of molecular solids can be understood in terms of the formation and migration of excitons, electron–hole pairs, from molecule to molecule. 21. The spectroscopic properties of metallic conductors and semiconductors can be understood in terms of the lightinduced promotion of electrons from valence bands to conduction bands. 22. Examples of solid state lasers include the neodymium laser, the titanium sapphire laser, and diode lasers. 23. Nonlinear optical phenomena arise from changes in the optical properties of a material in the presence of an intense field from electromagnetic radiation. Examples include second harmonic generation, and the optical Kerr effect. 24. A bulk sample exposed to a magnetic field of strength H acquires a magnetization, M = χH, where χ is the dimensionless volume magnetic susceptibility. When χ < 0, the material is diamagnetic and moves out of a magnetic field. When χ > 0, the material is paramagnetic and moves into a magnetic field. 25. The temperature dependence of χm is given by the Curie law χm = A + C/T, where A = NAµ0ξ, C = NAµ0m2 /3k, and ξ is the magnetizability, a measure of the extent to which a magnetic dipole moment may be induced in a molecule. 26. Ferromagnetism is the cooperative alignment of electron spins in a material and gives rise to strong magnetization. Antiferromagnetism results from alternating spin orientations in a material and leads to weak magnetization. 27. Temperature-independent paramagnetism arises from induced electron currents within the orbitals of a molecule that are occupied in its ground state. 28. Superconductors conduct electricity without resistance below a critical temperature Tc. Type I superconductors show abrupt loss of superconductivity when an applied magnetic field exceeds a critical value Hc characteristic of the material. They are also completely diamagnetic below Hc. Type II superconductors show a gradual loss of superconductivity and diamagnetism with increasing magnetic field. Further reading Articles and texts C.D. Graham, Jr., Magnetic materials. In Encyclopedia of applied physics, G.L. Trigg (ed.), 9, 1 VCH, New York (1994). W.B. Pearson and C. Chieh, Crystallography. In Encyclopedia of applied physics, G.L. Trigg (ed.), 4, 385 VCH, New York (1992). W.D. Callister, Jr., Materials science and engineering: an introduction. Wiley, New York (2000). P.A. Cox, The electronic structure and chemistry of solids. Oxford University Press (1987). O. Svelto, Principles of lasers. Plenum, New York (1998). M.A. White, Properties of materials. Oxford University Press (2000). Sources of data and information D.R. Lide (ed.), CRC Handbook of Chemistry and Physics, Sections 3, 12, 13, and 15, CRC Press, Boca Raton (2000). D. Sangeeta and J.R. LaGraff, Inorganic materials chemistry desk reference, CRC Press, Boca Raton (2004). Discussion questions 20.1 Explain how planes of lattice points are labelled. 20.2 Describe the procedure for identifying the type and size of a cubic unit cell. 20.3 What is meant by a systematic absence? How do they arise? 20.4 Describe the phase problem and explain how it may be overcome. 20.5 Describe the structures of elemental metallic solids in terms of the packing of hard spheres. To what extent is the hard-sphere model inaccurate? 20.6 Describe the caesium-chloride and rock-salt structures in terms of the occupation of holes in expanded close-packed lattices. 20.7 Explain how X-ray diffraction can be used to determine the absolute configuration of molecules. 20.8 Explain how metallic conductors and semiconductors are identified and explain their electrical and optical properties in terms of band theory. 20.9 Describe the characteristics of the Fermi–Dirac distribution. Why is it appropriate to call the parameter µ a chemical potential? 20.10 To what extent are the electric and magnetic properties of molecules analogous? How do they differ? 740 20 MATERIALS 2: THE SOLID STATE Exercises 20.1a Equivalent lattice points within the unit cell of a Bravais lattice have identical surroundings. What points within a face-centred cubic unit cell are equivalent to the point (1 –2, 0, 0)? 20.1b Equivalent lattice points within the unit cell of a Bravais lattice have identical surroundings. What points within a body-centred cubic unit cell are equivalent to the point (1 –2, 0, 1 –2)? 20.2a Find the Miller indices of the planes that intersect the crystallographic axes at the distances (2a, 3b, 2c) and (2a, 2b, ∞c). 20.2b Find the Miller indices of the planes that intersect the crystallographic axes at the distances (1a, 3b, −c) and (2a, 3b, 4c). 20.3a Calculate the separations of the planes {111}, {211}, and {100} in a crystal in which the cubic unit cell has side 432 pm. 20.3b Calculate the separations of the planes {121}, {221}, and {244} in a crystal in which the cubic unit cell has side 523 pm. 20.4a The glancing angle of a Bragg reflection from a set of crystal planes separated by 99.3 pm is 20.85°. Calculate the wavelength of the X-rays. 20.4b The glancing angle of a Bragg reflection from a set of crystal planes separated by 128.2 pm is 19.76°. Calculate the wavelength of the X-rays. 20.5a What are the values of 2θ of the first three diffraction lines of bcc iron (atomic radius 126 pm) when the X-ray wavelength is 58 pm? 20.5b What are the values of 2θ of the first three diffraction lines of fcc gold {atomic radius 144 pm) when the X-ray wavelength is 154 pm? 20.6a Copper Kα radiation consists of two components of wavelengths 154.433 pm and 154.051 pm. Calculate the separation of the diffraction lines arising from the two components in a powder diffraction pattern recorded in a circular camera of radius 5.74 cm (with the sample at the centre) from planes of separation 77.8 pm. 20.6b A synchrotron source produces X-radiation at a range of wavelengths. Consider two components of wavelengths 95.401 and 96.035 pm. Calculate the separation of the diffraction lines arising from the two components in a powder diffraction pattern recorded in a circular camera of radius 5.74 cm (with the sample at the centre) from planes of separation 82.3 pm. 20.7a The compound Rb3TlF6 has a tetragonal unit cell with dimensions a = 651 pm and c = 934 pm. Calculate the volume of the unit cell. 20.7b Calculate the volume of the hexagonal unit cell of sodium nitrate, for which the dimensions are a = 1692.9 pm and c = 506.96 pm. 20.8a The orthorhombic unit cell of NiSO4 has the dimensions a = 634 pm, b = 784 pm, and c = 516 pm, and the density of the solid is estimated as 3.9 g cm−3 . Determine the number of formula units per unit cell and calculate a more precise value of the density. 20.8b An orthorhombic unit cell of a compound of molar mass 135.01 g mol−1 has the dimensions a = 589 pm, b = 822 pm, and c = 798 pm. The density of the solid is estimated as 2.9 g cm−3 . Determine the number of formula units per unit cell and calculate a more precise value of the density. 20.9a The unit cells of SbCl3 are orthorhombic with dimensions a = 812 pm, b = 947 pm, and c = 637 pm. Calculate the spacing, d, of the (411) planes. 20.9b An orthorhombic unit cell has dimensions a = 679 pm, b = 879 pm, and c = 860 pm. Calculate the spacing, d, of the (322) planes. 20.10a A substance known to have a cubic unit cell gives reflections with Cu Kα radiation (wavelength 154 pm) at glancing angles 19.4°, 22.5°, 32.6°, and 39.4°. The reflection at 32.6° is known to be due to the (220) planes. Index the other reflections. 20.10b A substance known to have a cubic unit cell gives reflections with radiation of wavelength 137 pm at the glancing angles 10.7°, 13.6°, 17.7°, and 21.9°. The reflection at 17.7° is known to be due to the (111) planes. Index the other reflections. 20.11a Potassium nitrate crystals have orthorhombic unit cells of dimensions a = 542 pm, b = 917 pm, and c = 645 pm. Calculate the glancing angles for the (100), (010), and (111) reflections using CuKα radiation (154 pm). 20.11b Calcium carbonate crystals in the form of aragonite have orthorhombic unit cells of dimensions a = 574.1 pm, b = 796.8 pm, and c = 495.9 pm. Calculate the glancing angles for the (100), (010), and (111) reflections using radiation of wavelength 83.42 pm (from aluminium). 20.12a Copper(I) chloride forms cubic crystals with four formula units per unit cell. The only reflections present in a powder photograph are those with either all even indices or all odd indices. What is the (Bravais) lattice type of the unit cell? 20.12b A powder diffraction photograph from tungsten shows lines that index as (110), (200), (211), (220), (310), (222), (321), (400), . . . Identify the (Bravais) lattice type of the unit cell. 20.13a The coordinates, in units of a, of the atoms in a body-centred cubic lattice are (0,0,0), (0,1,0), (0,0,1), (0,1,1), (1,0,0), (1,1,0), (1,0,1), and (1,1,1). Calculate the structure factors Fhkl when all the atoms are identical. 20.13b The coordinates, in units of a, of the atoms in a body-centred cubic lattice are (0,0,0), (0,1,0), (0,0,1), (0,1,1), (1,0,0), (1,1,0), (1,0,1), (1,1,1), and (1 –2,1 –2,1 –2). Calculate the structure factors Fhkl when all the atoms are identical. 20.14a Calculate the packing fraction for close-packed cylinders. 20.14b Calculate the packing fraction for equilateral triangular rods stacked as shown in 2. 20.15a Verify that the radius ratios for sixfold coordination is 0.414. 20.15b Verify that the radius ratios for eightfold coordination is 0.732. 20.16a From the data in Table 20.3 determine the radius of the smallest cation that can have (a) sixfold and (b) eightfold coordination with the O2− ion. 20.16b From the data in Table 20.3 determine the radius of the smallest cation that can have (a) sixfold and (b) eightfold coordination with the K+ ion. 20.17a Calculate the atomic packing factor for diamond. 20.17b Calculate the atomic packing factor for a side-centred (C) cubic unit cell. 2 PROBLEMS 741 20.18a Is there an expansion or a contraction as titanium transforms from hcp to body-centred cubic? The atomic radius of titanium is 145.8 pm in hcp but 142.5 pm in bcc. 20.18b Is there an expansion or a contraction as iron transforms from hcp to bcc? The atomic radius of iron is 126 pm in hcp but 122 pm in bcc. 20.19a In a Patterson synthesis, the spots correspond to the lengths and directions of the vectors joining the atoms in a unit cell. Sketch the pattern that would be obtained for a planar, triangular isolated BF3 molecule. 20.19b In a Patterson synthesis, the spots correspond to the lengths and directions of the vectors joining the atoms in a unit cell. Sketch the pattern that would be obtained from the C atoms in an isolated benzene molecule. 20.20a What velocity should neutrons have if they are to have wavelength 50 pm? 20.20b Calculate the wavelength of neutrons that have reached thermal equilibrium by collision with a moderator at 300 K. 20.21a Derive the Born–Mayer equation (eqn 20.15) by calculating the energy at which d(EP + E*P)/dd = 0, with EP and E*P given by eqns 20.13 and 20.14, respectively. 20.21b Calculate the lattice enthalpy of MgBr2 from the following data: ∆H/(kJ mol−1 ) Sublimation of Mg(s) +148 Ionization of Mg(g) to Mg2+ (g) +2187 Vaporization of Br2(l) +31 Dissociation of Br2(g) +193 Electron attachment to Br(g) −331 Formation of MgBr2(s) from Mg(s) and Br2(l) −524 20.22a Cotton consists of the polymer cellulose, which is a linear chain of glucose molecules. The chains are held together by hydrogen bonding. When a cotton shirt is ironed, it is first moistened, then heated under pressure. Explain this process. 20.22b Sections of the solid fuel rocket boosters of the space shuttle Challenger were sealed together with O-ring rubber seals of circumference 11 m. These seals failed at 0°C, a temperature well above the crystallization temperature of the rubber. Speculate on why the failure occurred. 20.23a Young’s modulus for polyethylene at room temperature is 1.2 GPa. What strain will be produced when a mass of 1.0 kg is suspended from a polyethylene thread of diameter 1.0 mm? 20.23b Young’s modulus for iron at room temperature is 215 GPa. What strain will be produced when a mass of 10.0 kg is suspended from an iron wire of diameter 0.10 mm? 20.24a Poisson’s ratio for polyethylene is 0.45. What change in volume takes place when a cube of polyethylene of volume 1.0 cm3 is subjected to a uniaxial stress that produces a strain of 1.0 per cent? 20.24b Poisson’s ratio for lead is 0.41. What change in volume takes place when a cube of lead of volume 1.0 dm3 is subjected to a uniaxial stress that produces a strain of 2.0 per cent? 20.25a Is arsenic-doped germanium a p-type or n-type semiconductor? 20.25b Is gallium-doped germanium a p-type or n-type semiconductor? 20.26a The promotion of an electron from the valence band into the conduction band in pure TIO2 by light absorption requires a wavelength of less than 350 nm. Calculate the energy gap in electronvolts between the valence and conduction bands. 20.26b The band gap in silicon is 1.12 eV. Calculate the minimum frequency of electromagnetic radiation that results in promotion of electrons from the valence to the conduction band. 20.27a The magnetic moment of CrCl3 is 3.81µB. How many unpaired electrons does the Cr possess? 20.27b The magnetic moment of Mn2+ in its complexes is typically 5.3µB. How many unpaired electrons does the ion possess? 20.28a Calculate the molar susceptibility of benzene given that its volume susceptibility is −7.2 × 10−7 and its density 0.879 g cm−3 at 25°C. 20.28b Calculate the molar susceptibility of cyclohexane given that its volume susceptibility is −7.9 × 10−7 and its density 811 kg m−3 at 25°C. 20.29a According to Lewis theory, an O2 molecule should be diamagnetic. However, experimentally it is found that χm/(m3 mol−1 ) = (1.22 × 10−5 K)/T. Determine the number of unpaired spins in O2. How is the problem of the Lewis structure resolved? 20.29b Predict the molar susceptibility of nitrogen dioxide at 298 K. Why does the molar susceptibility of a sample of nitrogen dioxide gas decrease as it is compressed? 20.30a Data on a single crystal of MnF2 give χm = 0.1463 cm3 mol−1 at 294.53 K. Determine the effective number of unpaired electrons in this compound and compare your result with the theoretical value. 20.30b Data on a single crystal of NiSO4·7H2O give χm = 6.00 × 10−8 m3 mol−1 at 298 K. Determine the effective number of unpaired electrons in this compound and compare your result with the theoretical value. 20.31a Estimate the spin-only molar susceptibility of CuSO4·5H2O at 25°C. 20.31b Estimate the spin-only molar susceptibility of MnSO4·4H2O at 298 K. 20.32a Approximately how large must the magnetic induction, B, be for the orientational energy of an S = 1 system to be comparable to kT at 298 K? 20.32b Estimate the ratio of populations of the MS states of a system with S = 1 in 15.0 T at 298 K. Problems* Numerical problems 20.1 In the early days of X-ray crystallography there was an urgent need to know the wavelengths of X-rays. One technique was to measure the diffraction angle from a mechanically ruled grating. Another method was to estimate the separation of lattice planes from the measured density of a crystal. The density of NaCl is 2.17 g cm−3 and the (100) reflection using PdKα radiation occurred at 6.0°. Calculate the wavelength of the X-rays. 20.2 The element polonium crystallizes in a cubic system. Bragg reflections, with X-rays of wavelength 154 pm, occur at sin θ = 0.225, 0.316, and 0.388 from the (100), (110), and (111) sets of planes. The separation between the * Problems denoted with the symbol ‡ were supplied by Charles Trapp and Carmen Giunta. 742 20 MATERIALS 2: THE SOLID STATE sixth and seventh lines observed in the powder diffraction pattern is larger than between the fifth and sixth lines. Is the unit cell simple, body-centred, or face-centred? Calculate the unit cell dimension. 20.3 The unit cell dimensions of NaCl, KCl, NaBr, and KBr, all of which crystallize in face-centred cubic lattices, are 562.8 pm, 627.7 pm, 596.2 pm, and 658.6 pm, respectively. In each case, anion and cation are in contact along an edge of the unit cell. Do the data support the contention that ionic radii are constants independent of the counter-ion? 20.4 The powder diffraction patterns of (a) tungsten, (b) copper obtained in a camera of radius 28.7 mm are shown in Fig. 20.69. Both were obtained with 154 pm X-rays and the scales are marked. Identify the unit cell in each case, and calculate the lattice spacing. Estimate the metallic radii of W and Cu. 20.5 Elemental silver reflects X-rays of wavelength 154.18 pm at angles of 19.076°, 22.171°, and 32.256°. However, there are no other reflections at angles of less than 33°. Assuming a cubic unit cell, determine its type and dimension. Calculate the density of silver. 20.6 Genuine pearls consist of concentric layers of calcite crystals (CaCO3) in which the trigonal axes are oriented along the radii. The nucleus of a cultured pearl is a piece of mother-of-pearl that has been worked into a sphere on a lathe. The oyster then deposits concentric layers of calcite on the central seed. Suggest an X-ray method for distinguishing between real and cultured pearls. 20.7 In their book X-rays and crystal structures (which begins ‘It is now two years since Dr. Laue conceived the idea . . . ’) the Braggs give a number of simple examples of X-ray analysis. For instance, they report that the reflection from (100) planes in KCl occurs at 5° 23′, but for NaCl it occurs at 6° 0′ for Xrays of the same wavelength. If the side of the NaCl unit cell is 564 pm, what is the side of the KCl unit cell? The densities of KCl and NaCl are 1.99 g cm−3 and 2.17 g cm−3 respectively. Do these values support the X-ray analysis? 20.8 Calculate the coefficient of thermal expansion of diamond given that the (111) reflection shifts from 22° 2′ 25″ to 21° 57′ 59″ on heating a crystal from 100 K to 300 K and 154.0562 pm X-rays are used. 20.9 The carbon–carbon bond length in diamond is 154.45 pm. If diamond were considered to be a close-packed structure of hard spheres with radii equal to half the bond length, what would be its expected density? The diamond lattice is face-centred cubic and its actual density is 3.516 g cm−3 . Can you explain the discrepancy? 20.10 The volume of a monoclinic unit cell is abc sin β. Naphthalene has a monoclinic unit cell with two molecules per cell and sides in the ratio 1.377:1:1.436. The angle β is 122° 49′ and the density of the solid is 1.152 g cm−3 . Calculate the dimensions of the cell. 20.11 The structures of crystalline macromolecules may be determined by Xray diffraction techniques by methods similar to those for smaller molecules. Fully crystalline polyethylene has its chains aligned in an orthorhombic unit cell of dimensions 740 pm × 493 pm × 253 pm. There are two repeating Fig. 20.69 1 cm (a) (b) CH2CH2 units per unit cell. Calculate the theoretical density of fully crystalline polyethylene. The actual density ranges from 0.92 to 0.95 g cm−3 . 20.12 Construct the electron density along the x-axis of a crystal given the following structure factors: h 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 Fh +30.0 +8.2 +6.5 +4.1 +5.5 −2.4 +5.4 +3.2 −1.0 +1.1 h 10 11 12 13 14 15 Fh +6.5 +5.2 −4.3 −1.2 +0.1 +2.1 20.13 The scattering of electrons or neutrons from a pair of nuclei separated by a distance Rij and orientated at a definite angle to the incident beam can be calculated. When the molecule consists of a number of atoms, we sum over the contribution from all pairs, and find that the total intensity has an angular variation given by the Wierl equation: I(θ) = ∑i,j fi fj s = sin 1 –2θ where λ is the wavelength of the electrons in the beam and θ is the scattering angle. The electron scattering factor, f, is a measure of the intensity of the electron scattering powers of the atoms. (a) Predict from the Wierl equation the positions of the first maximum and first minimum in the neutron and electron diffraction patterns of a Br2 molecule obtained with neutrons of wavelength 78 pm wavelength and electrons of wavelength 4.0 pm. (b) Use the Wierl equation to predict the appearance of the 10.0 keV electron diffraction pattern of CCl4 with an (as yet) undertermined C-Cl bond length but of known tetrahedral symmetry. Take fCl = 17f and fC = 6f and note that R(Cl,Cl) = (8/3)1/2 R(C,Cl). Plot I/f2 against positions of the maxima, which occurred at 3° 0′, 5° 22′, and 7° 54′, and minima, which occurred at 1° 46′, 4° 6′, 6° 40′, and 9° 10′. What is the C-Cl bond length in CCl4? 20.14‡ B.A. Bovenzi and G.A. Pearse, Jr. (J. Chem. Soc. Dalton Trans. 2793 (1997)) synthesized coordination compounds of the tridentate ligand pyridine-2,6-diamidoxime (C7H9N5O2). The compound, which they isolated from the reaction of the ligand with CuSO4 (aq), did not contain a [Cu(C7H9N5O2)2]2+ complex cation as expected. Instead, X-ray diffraction analysis revealed a linear polymer of formula [Cu(Cu(C7H9N5O2)(SO4) · 2H2O]n, which features bridging sulfate groups. The unit cell was primitive monoclinic with a = 1.0427 nm, b = 0.8876 nm, c = 1.3777 nm, and β = 93.254°. The mass density of the crystals is 2.024 g cm−3 . How many monomer units are there per unit cell? 20.15‡ D. Sellmann, M.W. Wemple, W. Donaubauer, and F.W. Heinemann (Inorg. Chem. 36, 1397 (1997)) describe the synthesis and reactivity of the ruthenium nitrido compound [N(C4H9)4][Ru(N)(S2C6H4)2]. The ruthenium complex anion has the two 1,2-benzenedithiolate ligands (3) at the base of a rectangular pyramid and the nitrido ligand at the apex. Compute the mass density of the compound given that it crystallizes into an orthorhombic unit cell with a = 3.6881 nm, b = 0.9402 nm, and c = 1.7652 nm and eight formula units per cell. Replacing the ruthenium with an osmium results in a compound with the same crystal structure and a unit cell with a volume less than 1 per cent larger. Estimate the mass density of the osmium analogue. 20.16 Aided by the Born–Mayer equation for the lattice enthalpy and a Born–Haber cycle, show that formation of CaCl is an exothermic process (the sublimation enthalpy of Ca(s) is 176 kJ mol−1 ). Show that an explanation 4π λ sin sRij sRij PROBLEMS 743 for the nonexistence of CaCl can be found in the reaction enthalpy for the reaction 2CaCl(s) → Ca(s) + CaCl2. 20.17 In an intrinsic semiconductor, the band gap is so small that the Fermi–Dirac distribution results in some electrons populating the conduction band. It follows from the exponential form of the Fermi–Dirac distribution that the conductance G, the inverse of the resistance (with units of siemens, 1 S = 1 Ω−1 ), of an intrinsic semiconductor should have an Arrhenius-like temperature dependence, shown in practice to have the form G = G0e−Eg/2kT , where Eg is the band gap. The conductance of a sample of germanium varied with temperature as indicated below. Estimate the value of Eg. T/K 312 354 420 G/S 0.0847 0.429 2.86 20.18 Here we investigate quantitatively the spectra of molecular solids. We begin by considering a dimer, with each monomer having a single transition with transition dipole moment µmon and wavenumber #mon. We assume that the ground state wavefunctions are not perturbed as a result of dimerization and then write the dimer excited state wavefunctions Ψi as linear combinations of the excited state wavefunctions ψ1 and ψ2 of the monomer: Ψi = cjψ1 + ckψ2. Now we write the hamiltonian matrix with diagonal elements set to the energy between the excited and ground state of the monomer (which, expressed as a wavenumber, is simply #mon), and off-diagonal elements correspond to the energy of interaction between the transition dipoles. Using the arrangement discussed in Illustration 20.1, we write this interaction energy (as a wavenumber) as: β = (1 − 3 cos2 θ) It follows that the hamiltonian matrix is @ = The eigenvalues of the matrix are the dimer transition wavenumbers #1 and #2. The eigenvectors are the wavefunctions for the excited states of the dimer and have the form . (a) The intensity of absorption of incident radiation is proportional to the square of the transition dipole moment (Section 9.10). The monomer transition dipole moment is µmon = ∫ψ*1Nψ0dτ = ∫ψ*2Nψ0dτ , where ψ0 is the wavefunction of the monomer ground state. Assume that the dimer ground state may also be described by ψ0 and show that the transition dipole moment µi of each dimer transition is given by µi = µmon(cj + ck). (b) Consider a dimer of monomers with µmon = 4.00 D, #mon = 25 000 cm−1 , and r = 0.5 nm. How do the transition wavenumbers #1 and #2 vary with the angle θ? The relative intensities of the dimer transitions may be estimated by calculating the ratio µ2 2 /µ1 2 . How does this ratio vary with the angle θ? (c) Now expand the treatment given above to a chain of N monomers (N = 5, 10, 15, and 20), with µmon = 4.00 D, #mon = 25 000 cm−1 , and r = 0.5 nm. For simplicity, assume that θ = 0 and that only nearest neighbours interact with interaction energy V. For example the hamiltonian matrix for the case N = 4 is @ = How does the wavenumber of the lowest energy transition vary with size of the chain? How does the transition dipole moment of the lowest energy transition vary with the size of the chain? 20.19‡ J.J. Dannenberg, D. Liotard, P. Halvick, and J.C. Rayez (J. Phys. Chem. 100, 9631 (1996)) carried out theoretical studies of organic molecules consisting of chains of unsaturated four-membered rings. The calculations # # # # mon mon mon mon V V V V V V 0 0 0 0 0 0 ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎜ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ ⎟ ⎟ D E F cj ck A B C D E F β #mon #mon β A B C µ2 mon 4πε0hcr3 suggest that such compounds have large numbers of unpaired spins, and that they should therefore have unusual magnetic properties. For example, the lowest-energy state of the five-ring compound C22H14 (4) is computed to have S = 3, but the energies of S = 2 and S = 4 structures are each predicted to be 50 kJ mol−1 higher in energy. Compute the molar magnetic susceptibility of these three low-lying levels at 298 K. Estimate the molar susceptibility at 298 K if each level is present in proportion to its Boltzmann factor (effectively assuming that the degeneracy is the same for all three of these levels). 20.20 Lead has Tc = 7.19 K and Hc = 63 901 A m−1 . At what temperature does lead become superconducting in a magnetic field of 20 kA m−1 ? 20.21‡ P.G. Radaelli, M. Marezio, M. Perroux, S. de Brion, J.L. Tholence, Q. Huang, and A. Santoro (Science 265, 380 (1994)) report the synthesis and structure of a material that becomes superconducting at temperatures below 45 K. The compound is based on a layered compound Hg2Ba2YCu2O8-δ, which has a tetragonal unit cell with a = 0.38606 nm and c = 2.8915 nm; each unit cell contains two formula units. The compound is made superconducting by partially replacing Y by Ca, accompanied by a change in unit cell volume by less than 1 per cent. Estimate the Ca content x in superconducting Hg2Ba2Y1−x CaxCu2O7.55 given that the mass density of the compound is 7.651 g cm−3 . Theoretical problems 20.22 Show that the separation of the (hkl) planes in an orthorhombic crystal with sides a, b, and c is given by eqn 20.3. 20.23 Show that the volume of a triclinic unit cell of sides a, b, and c and angles α, β, and γ is V = abc(1 − cos2 α − cos2 β − cos2 γ + 2 cos α cos β cos γ)1/2 Use this expression to derive expressions for monoclinic and orthorhombic unit cells. For the derivation, it may be helpful to use the result from vector analysis that V = a·b × c and to calculate V2 initially. 20.24 Calculate the packing fractions of (a) a primitive cubic lattice, (b) a bcc unit cell, (c) an fcc unit cell. 20.25 The coordinates of the four I atoms in the unit cell of KIO4 are (0,0,0), (0,1 –2,1 –2), (1 –2,1 –2,1 –2), (1 –2,0,3 –4). By calculating the phase of the I reflection in the structure factor, show that the I atoms contribute no net intensity to the (114) reflection. 20.26 The coordinates, in units of a, of the A atoms, with scattering factor fA, in a cubic lattice are (0,0,0), (0,1,0), (0,0,1), (0,1,1), (1,0,0), (1,1,0), (1,0,1), and (1,1,1). There is also a B atom, with scattering factor fB, at (1 –2,1 –2,1 –2). Calculate the structure factors Fhkl and predict the form of the powder diffraction pattern when (a) fA = f, fB = 0, (b) fB = 1 –2 fA, and (c) fA = fB = f. 20.27 For an isotropic substance, the moduli and Poisson’s ratio may be expressed in terms of two parameters λ and µ called the Lamé constants: E = K = G = µ νP = Use the Lamé constants to confirm the relations between G, K, and E given in eqn 20.18. 20.28 When energy levels in a band form a continuum, the density of states ρ(E), the number of levels in an energy range divided by the width of the range, may be written as ρ(E) = dk/dE, where dk is the change in the quantum number k and dE is the energy change. (a) Use eqn 20.21 to show that λ 3(λ + µ) 3λ + 2µ 3 µ(3λ + 2µ) λ + µ 744 20 MATERIALS 2: THE SOLID STATE ρ(E) = − 1 − 2 1/2 where k, N, α, and β have the meanings described in Section 20.9. (b) Use the expression above to show that ρ(E) becomes infinite as E approaches α ± 2β. That is, show that the density of states increases towards the edges of the bands in a one-dimensional metallic conductor. 20.29 The treatment in Problem 20.28 applies only to one-dimensional solids. In three dimensions, the variation of density of states is more like that shown in Fig. 20.70. Account for the fact that in a three-dimensional solid the greatest density of states lies near the centre of the band and the lowest density at the edges. 20.30 Show that, if a substance responds nonlinearly to two sources of radiation, one of frequency ω1 and the other of frequency ω2, then it may give rise to radiation of the sum and difference of the two frequencies. This nonlinear optical phenomenon is known as frequency mixing and is used to expand the wavelength range of lasers in laboratory applications, such as spectroscopy and photochemistry. 20.31 The magnetizability, ξ, and the volume and molar magnetic susceptibilities can be calculated from the wavefunctions of molecules. For instance, the magnetizability of a hydrogenic atom is given by the expression ξ = −(e2 /6me)͗r2 ͘, where ͗r2 ͘ is the (expectation) mean value of r2 in the atom. Calculate ξ and χm for the ground state of a hydrogenic atom. Fig. 20.70 Density of states, Energy s-band p-band r 5 6 7 D E F E − α 2β A B C 1 2 3 (N + 1)/2πβ 20.32 Nitrogen dioxide, a paramagnetic compound, is in equilibrium with its dimer, dinitrogen tetroxide, a diamagnetic compound. Derive an expression in terms of the equilibrium constant, K, for the dimerization to show how the molar susceptibility varies with the pressure of the sample. Suggest how the susceptibility might be expected to vary as the temperature is changed at constant pressure. 20.33 An NO molecule has thermally accessible electronically excited states. It also has an unpaired electron, and so may be expected to be paramagnetic. However, its ground state is not paramagnetic because the magnetic moment of the orbital motion of the unpaired electron almost exactly cancels the spin magnetic moment. The first excited state (at 121 cm−1 ) is paramagnetic because the orbital magnetic moment adds to, rather than cancels, the spin magnetic moment. The upper state has a magnetic moment of 2µB. Because the upper state is thermally accessible, the paramagnetic susceptibility of NO shows a pronounced temperature dependence even near room temperature. Calculate the molar paramagnetic susceptibility of NO and plot it as a function of temperature. Applications: to biochemistry and nanoscience 20.34 Although the crystallization of large biological molecules may not be as readily accomplished as that of small molecules, their crystal lattices are no different. Tobacco seed globulin forms face-centred cubic crystals with unit cell dimension of 12.3 nm and a density of 1.287 g cm−3 . Determine its molar mass. 20.35 What features in an X-ray diffraction pattern suggest a helical conformation for a biological macromolecule? Use Fig. 20.26 to deduce as much quantitative information as you can about the shape and size of a DNA molecule. 20.36 A transistor is a semiconducting device that is commonly used either as a switch or an amplifier of electrical signals. Prepare a brief report on the design of a nanometre-sized transistor that uses a carbon nanotube as a component. A useful starting point is the work summarized by Tans et al. Nature 393, 49 (1998). 20.37 The tip of a scanning tunnelling microscope can be used to move atoms on a surface. The movement of atoms and ions depends on their ability to leave one position and stick to another, and therefore on the energy changes that occur. As an illustration, consider a two-dimensional square lattice of univalent positive and negative ions separated by 200 pm, and consider a cation on top of this array. Calculate, by direct summation, its Coulombic interaction when it is in an empty lattice point directly above an anion. PART 3 Change Part 3 considers the processes by which change occurs. We prepare the ground for a discussion of the rates of reactions by considering the motion of molecules in gases and in liquids. Then we establish the precise meaning of reaction rate, and see how the overall rate, and the complex behaviour of some reactions, may be expressed in terms of elementary steps and the atomic events that take place when molecules meet. Characteristic physical and chemical events take place at surfaces, including catalysis, and we see how to describe them. A special type of surface is that of an electrode, and we shall see how to describe and understand the rate at which electrons are transferred between an electrode and species in solution. 21 Molecules in motion 22 The rates of chemical reactions 23 The kinetics of complex reactions 24 Molecular reaction dynamics 25 Processes at solid surfaces This page intentionally left blank Molecules in motion One of the simplest types of molecular motion to describe is the random motion of molecules of a perfect gas. We see that a simple theory accounts for the pressure of a gas and the rates at which molecules and energy migrate through gases. Molecular mobility is particularly important in liquids. Another simple kind of motion is the largely uniform motion of ions in solution in the presence of an electric field. Molecular and ionic motion have common features and, by considering them from a more general viewpoint, we derive expressions that govern the migration of properties through matter. One of the most useful consequences of this general approach is the formulation of the diffusion equation, which is an equation that shows how matter and energy spread through media of various kinds. Finally, we build a simple model for all types of molecular motion, in which the molecules migrate in a series of small steps, and see that it accounts for many of the properties of migrating molecules in both gases and condensed phases. The general approach we describe in this chapter provides techniques for discussing the motion of all kinds of particles in all kinds of fluids. We set the scene by considering a simple type of motion, that of molecules in a perfect gas, and go on to see that molecular motion in liquids shows a number of similarities. We shall concentrate on the transport properties of a substance, its ability to transfer matter, energy, or some other property from one place to another. Four examples of transport properties are Diffusion, the migration of matter down a concentration gradient. Thermal conduction, the migration of energy down a temperature gradient. Electric conduction, the migration of electric charge along an electrical potential gradient. Viscosity, the migration of linear momentum down a velocity gradient. It is convenient to include in the discussion effusion, the emergence of a gas from a container through a small hole. Molecular motion in gases Here we present the kinetic model of a perfect gas as a starting point for the discussion of its transport properties. In the kinetic model of gases we assume that the only contribution to the energy of the gas is from the kinetic energies of the molecules. The kinetic model is one of the most remarkable—and arguably most beautiful—models in physical chemistry for, from a set of very slender assumptions, powerful quantitative conclusions can be deduced. 21 Molecular motion in gases 21.1 The kinetic model of gases I21.1 Impact on astrophysics: The Sun as a ball of perfect gas 21.2 Collision with walls and surfaces 21.3 The rate of effusion 21.4 Transport properties of a perfect gas Molecular motion in liquids 21.5 Experimental results 21.6 The conductivities of electrolyte solutions 21.7 The mobilities of ions 21.8 Conductivities and ion–ion interactions I21.2 Impact on biochemistry: Ion channels and ion pumps Diffusion 21.9 The thermodynamic view 21.10 The diffusion equation I21.3 Impact on biochemistry: Transport of non-electrolytes across biological membranes 21.11 Diffusion probabilities 21.12 The statistical view Checklist of key ideas Further reading Further information 21.1: The transport characteristics of a perfect gas Discussion questions Exercises Problems 748 21 MOLECULES IN MOTION 21.1 The kinetic model of gases The kinetic model is based on three assumptions: 1 The gas consists of molecules of mass m in ceaseless random motion. 2 The size of the molecules is negligible, in the sense that their diameters are much smaller than the average distance travelled between collisions. 3 The molecules interact only through brief, infrequent, and elastic collisions. An elastic collision is a collision in which the total translational kinetic energy of the molecules is conserved. (a) Pressure and molecular speeds From the very economical assumptions of the kinetic model, we show in the following Justification that the pressure and volume of the gas are related by pV = 1 –3nMc2 (21.1)° where M = mNA, the molar mass of the molecules, and c is the rootmeansquarespeed of the molecules, the square root of the mean of the squares of the speeds, v, of the molecules: c = ͗v2 ͘1/2 [21.2] Justification 21.1 The pressure of a gas according to the kinetic model Consider the arrangement in Fig. 21.1. When a particle of mass m that is travelling with a component of velocity vx parallel to the x-axis collides with the wall on the right and is reflected, its linear momentum (the product of its mass and its velocity) changes from mvx before the collision to −mvx after the collision (when it is travelling in the opposite direction). The x-component of momentum therefore changes by 2mvx on each collision (the y- and z-components are unchanged). Many molecules collide with the wall in an interval ∆t, and the total change of momentum is the product of the change in momentum of each molecule multiplied by the number of molecules that reach the wall during the interval. Because a molecule with velocity component vx can travel a distance vx∆t along the x-axis in an interval ∆t, all the molecules within a distance vx∆t of the wall will strike it if they are travelling towards it (Fig. 21.2). It follows that, if the wall has area A, then all the particles in a volume A × vx∆t will reach the wall (if they are travelling towards it). The number density of particles is nNA/V, where n is the total amount of molecules in the container of volume V and NA is Avogadro’s constant, so the number of molecules in the volume Avx∆t is (nNA/V) × Avx∆t. At any instant, half the particles are moving to the right and half are moving to the left. Therefore, the average number of collisions with the wall during the interval ∆t is 1–2nNAAvx∆t/V. The total momentum change in that interval is the product of this number and the change 2mvx: Momentum change = × 2mvx = = where M = mNA. Next, to find the force, we calculate the rate of change of momentum, which is this change of momentum divided by the interval ∆t during which it occurs: Rate of change of momentum = nMAv2 x V nMAv2 x∆t V nmANAv2 x∆t V nNAAvx∆t 2V mvx -mvx x x Before collision After collision (a) (b) Fig. 21.1 The pressure of a gas arises from the impact of its molecules on the walls. In an elastic collision of a molecule with a wall perpendicular to the x-axis, the xcomponent of velocity is reversed but the y- and z-components are unchanged. x | |v tx D Volume = | |v t Ax D Area A Will Won’t Fig. 21.2 A molecule will reach the wall on the right within an interval ∆t if it is within a distance vx∆t of the wall and travelling to the right. 21.1 THE KINETIC MODEL OF GASES 749 This rate of change of momentum is equal to the force (by Newton’s second law of motion). It follows that the pressure, the force divided by the area, is Pressure = Not all the molecules travel with the same velocity, so the detected pressure, p, is the average (denoted ͗ . . . ͘) of the quantity just calculated: p = This expression already resembles the perfect gas equation of state. To write an expression of the pressure in terms of the root mean square speed, c, we begin by writing the speed of a single molecule, v, as v2 = v2 x + v2 y + v2 z. Because the root-mean-square speed, c, is defined as c = ͗v2 ͘1/2 (eqn 21.2), it follows that c2 = ͗v2 ͘ = ͗v2 x͘ + ͗v2 y͘ + ͗v2 z͘ However, because the molecules are moving randomly, all three averages are the same. It follows that c2 = 3͗v2 x͘. Equation 21.1 follows immediately by substituting ͗v2 x͘ = 1–3c2 into p = nM͗v2 x͘/V. Equation 21.1 is one of the key results of the kinetic model. We see that if the root mean square speed of the molecules depends only on the temperature, then at constant temperature pV = constant which is the content of Boyle’s law (Section 1.2). Moreover, for eqn 21.1 to be the equation of state of a perfect gas, its right-hand side must be equal to nRT. It follows that the root mean square speed of the molecules in a gas at a temperature T must be c = 1/2 (21.3)° We can conclude that the root mean square speed of the molecules of a gas is proportional to the square root of the temperature and inversely proportional to the square root of the molar mass. That is, the higher the temperature, the higher the root mean square speed of the molecules, and, at a given temperature, heavy molecules travel more slowly than light molecules. Sound waves are pressure waves, and for them to propagate the molecules of the gas must move to form regions of high and low pressure. Therefore, we should expect the root mean square speeds of molecules to be comparable to the speed of sound in air (340 m s−1 ). The root mean square speed of N2 molecules, for instance, is found from eqn 21.3 to be 515 m s−1 . Equation 21.3 is an expression for the mean square speed of molecules. However, in an actual gas the speeds of individual molecules span a wide range, and the collisions in the gas continually redistribute the speeds among the molecules. Before a collision, a molecule may be travelling rapidly, but after a collision it may be accelerated to a very high speed, only to be slowed again by the next collision. The fraction of molecules that have speeds in the range v to v + dv is proportional to the width of the range, and is written f(v)dv, where f(v) is called the distribution of speeds. The precise form of f for molecules of a gas at a temperature T was derived by J.C. Maxwell, and is f(v) = 4π 3/2 v2 e−Mv2 /2RT (21.4) D F M 2πRT A C D F 3RT M A C nM͗v2 x͘ V nMv2 x V 750 21 MOLECULES IN MOTION This expression is called the Maxwell distribution of speeds and is derived in the following Justification. Let’s consider its features, which are also shown pictorially in Fig. 21.3: 1 Equation 21.4 includes a decaying exponential function, the term e−Mv2 /2RT . Its presence implies that the fraction of molecules with very high speeds will be very small because e−x2 becomes very small when x2 is large. 2 The factor M/2RT multiplying v2 in the exponent is large when the molar mass, M, is large, so the exponential factor goes most rapidly towards zero when M is large. That is, heavy molecules are unlikely to be found with very high speeds. 3 The opposite is true when the temperature, T, is high: then the factor M/2RT in the exponent is small, so the exponential factor falls towards zero relatively slowly as v increases. In other words, a greater fraction of the molecules can be expected to have high speeds at high temperatures than at low temperatures. 4 A factor v2 (the term before the e) multiplies the exponential. This factor goes to zero as v goes to zero, so the fraction of molecules with very low speeds will also be very small. 5 The remaining factors (the term in parentheses in eqn 21.4 and the 4π) simply ensure that, when we add together the fractions over the entire range of speeds from zero to infinity, then we get 1. To use eqn 21.4 to calculate the fraction of molecules in a given narrow range of speeds, ∆v, we evaluate f(v) at the speed of interest, then multiply it by the width of the range of speeds of interest; that is, we form f(v)∆v. To use the distribution to calculate the fraction in a range of speeds that is too wide to be treated as infinitesimal, we evaluate the integral: Fraction in the range v1 to v2 = Ύ v2 v1 f(v)dv (21.5) This integral is the area under the graph of f as a function of v and, except in special cases, has to be evaluated numerically by using mathematical software (Fig. 21.4). Justification 21.2 The Maxwell distribution of speeds The Boltzmann distribution is a key result of physical chemistry and is treated fully in Section 16.1. It implies that the fraction of molecules with velocity components vx, vy, vz is proportional to an exponential function of their kinetic energy, which is E = 1–2mv2 x + 1–2mv2 y + 1–2mv2 z Therefore, we can use the relation ax+y+z+ · · · = ax ay az · · · to write f = Ke−E/kT = Ke−(1–– 2mv2 x+ 1–– 2mv2 y+ 1–– 2mv2 z)/kT = Ke−mv2 x/2kT e−mv2 y/2kT e−mv2 z/2kT where K is a constant of proportionality (at constant temperature) and fdvxdvydvz is the fraction of molecules in the velocity range vx to vx + dvx, vy to vy + dvy, and vz to vz + dvz. We see that the fraction factorizes into three factors, one for each axis, and we can write f = f(vx)f(vy)f(vz) with f(vx) = K1/3 e−mv2 x/2kT and likewise for the two other directions. To determine the constant K, we note that a molecule must have a velocity somewhere in the range −∞ < vx < ∞, so Ύ ∞ −∞ f(vx)dvx = 1 Speed, v Low temperature or high molecular mass High temperature or low molecular mass Intermediate temperature or molecular mass Relativenumbersofmolecules,()fv Fig. 21.3 The distribution of molecular speeds with temperature and molar mass. Note that the most probable speed (corresponding to the peak of the distribution) increases with temperature and with decreasing molar mass, and simultaneously the distribution becomes broader. Exploration (a) Plot different distributions by keeping the molar mass constant at 100 g mol−1 and varying the temperature of the sample between 200 K and 2000 K. (b) Use mathematical software or the Living graph applet from the text’s web site to evaluate numerically the fraction of molecules with speeds in the range 100 m s−1 to 200 m s−1 at 300 K and 1000 K. (c) Based on your observations, provide a molecular interpretation of temperature. 21.1 THE KINETIC MODEL OF GASES 751 vx vy vz v Surface area, 4pv 2 Thickness, dv Fig. 21.5 To evaluate the probability that a molecule has a speed in the range v to v + dv, we evaluate the total probability that the molecule will have a speed that is anywhere on the surface of a sphere of radius v = (vx 2 + vy 2 + vz 2 )1/2 by summing the probabilities that it is in a volume element dvxdvydvz at a distance v from the origin. Speed Relativenumberofmolecules v2v1 Fig. 21.4 To calculate the probability that a molecule will have a speed in the range v1 to v2, we integrate the distribution between those two limits; the integral is equal to the area of the curve between the limits, as shown shaded here. Substitution of the expression for f(vx) then gives 1 = K1/3 Ύ ∞ −∞ e−mv2 x/2kT dvx = K1/3 1/2 where we have used the standard integral Ύ ∞ −∞ e−ax2 dx = Therefore, K = (m/2πkT)3/2 = (M/2πRT)3/2 , where M is the molar mass of the molecules. At this stage we know that f(vx) = 1/2 e−Mv2 x/2RT (21.6) The probability that a molecule has a velocity in the range vx to vx + dvx, vy to vy + dvy, vz to vz + dvz is f(vx)f(vy)f(vz)dvxdvydvz = 3/2 e−Mv2 x/2RT dvxdvydvz where v2 = v2 x + v2 y + v2 z. The probability f(v)dv that the molecules have a speed in the range v to v + dv regardless of direction is the sum of the probabilities that the velocity lies in any of the volume elements dvxdvydvz forming a spherical shell of radius v and thickness dv (Fig. 21.5). The sum of the volume elements on the righthand side of the last equation is the volume of this shell, 4πv2 dv. Therefore, f(v) = 4π 3/2 v2 e−Mv2 x/2RT as given in eqn 21.4. Example 21.1 Calculating the mean speed of molecules in a gas What is the mean speed, K, of N2 molecules in air at 25°C? Method We need to use the results of probability theory summarized in Appendix 2. In this case, we are asked to calculate the mean speed, not the root mean square speed. A mean speed is calculated by multiplying each speed by the fraction of molecules that have that speed, and then adding all the products together. When the speed varies over a continuous range, the sum is replaced by an integral. To employ this approach here, we note that the fraction of molecules with a speed in the range v to v + dv is f(v)dv, so the product of this fraction and the speed is vf(v)dv. The mean speed, K, is obtained by evaluating the integral K = Ύ ∞ 0 vf(v)dv with f given in eqn 21.4. Answer The integral required is K = 4π 3/2 Ύ ∞ 0 v3 e−Mv2 /2RT dv = 4π 3/2 × 1 –2 2 = 1/2 D F 8RT πM A C D F 2RT M A C D F M 2πRT A C D F M 2πRT A C D E F M 2πRT A B C D E F M 2πRT A B C D E F M 2πRT A B C π a D E F 2πkT m A B C 752 21 MOLECULES IN MOTION Comment 21.1 To find the location of the peak of the distribution, differentiate f with respect to V and look for the value of V at which the derivative is zero (other than at 1 = 0 and 1 = ∞). fvMRT()/4(/2)pp1/2 v RT M/(2 / ) 1/2 1/e 10 (4/ )p 1/2 c RT M= (3 / )1/2 c RT M* (2 / )= 1/2 (3/2)1/2 c RT M= (8 / )p 1/2 Fig. 21.6 A summary of the conclusions that can be deduced from the Maxwell distribution for molecules of molar mass M at a temperature T: c* is the most probable speed, K is the mean speed, and c is the root mean square speed. where we have used the standard result from tables of integrals (or software) that Ύ ∞ 0 x3 e−ax2 dx = Substitution of the data then gives K = 1/2 = 475 ms−1 where we have used 1 J = 1 kg m2 s−2 . Self-test 21.1 Evaluate the root mean square speed of the molecules by integration. You will need the integral Ύ ∞ 0 x4 e−ax2 dx = 3 –8 1/2 [c = (3RT/M)1/2 , 515 m s−1 ] As shown in Example 21.1, we can use the Maxwell distribution to evaluate the mean speed, K, of the molecules in a gas: K = 1/2 (21.7) We can identify the most probable speed, c*, from the location of the peak of the dis- tribution: c* = 1/2 (21.8) Figure 21.6 summarizes these results. The relative mean speed, Krel, the mean speed with which one molecule approaches another, can also be calculated from the distribution: Krel = 21/2 K (21.9) This result is much harder to derive, but the diagram in Fig. 21.7 should help to show that it is plausible. The last result can also be generalized to the relative mean speed of two dissimilar molecules of masses mA and mB: Krel = 1/2 µ = (21.10) Note that the molecular masses (not the molar masses) and Boltzmann’s constant, k = R/NA, appear in this expression; the quantity µ is called the reduced mass of the molecules. Equation 21.10 turns into eqn 21.7 when the molecules are identical (that is, mA = mB = m, so µ = 1 –2m). The Maxwell distribution has been verified experimentally. For example, molecular speeds can be measured directly with a velocity selector (Fig. 21.8). The spinning cylinder has channels that permit the passage of only those molecules moving through them at the appropriate speed, and the number of molecules can be determined by collecting them at a detector. (b) The collision frequency A qualitative picture of the events taking place in a gas was first described in Section 1.2. The kinetic model enables us to make that picture more quantitative. In particular, mAmB mA + mB D F 8kT πµ A C D F 2RT M A C D F 8RT πM A C D F π a5 A C D F 8 × (8.3141 J K−1 mol−1 ) × (298 K) π × (28.02 × 10−3 kg mol−1 ) A C 1 2a2 21.1 THE KINETIC MODEL OF GASES 753 it enables us to calculate the frequency with which molecular collisions occur and the distance a molecule travels on average between collisions. We count a ‘hit’ whenever the centres of two molecules come within a distance d of each other, where d, the collision diameter, is of the order of the actual diameters of the molecules (for impenetrable hard spheres d is the diameter). As we show in the following Justification, we can use kinetic model to deduce that the collisionfrequency, z, the number of collisions made by one molecule divided by the time interval during which the collisions are counted, when there are N molecules in a volume V is z = σKrelN (21.11a)° with N = N/V and Krel given in eqn 21.10. The area σ = πd2 is called the collision crosssection of the molecules. Some typical collision cross-sections are given in Table 21.1 (they are obtained by the techniques described in Section 18.6). In terms of the pressure, z = (21.11b)° Justification 21.3 Using the kinetic model to calculate the collision frequency We consider the positions of all the molecules except one to be frozen. Then we note what happens as one mobile molecule travels through the gas with a mean relative speed Krel for a time ∆t. In doing so it sweeps out a ‘collision tube’ of cross-sectional area σ = πd2 and length Krel∆t, and therefore of volume σKrel∆t (Fig. 21.9). The number of stationary molecules with centres inside the collision tube is given by the σKrelp kT Fig. 21.7 A simplified version of the argument to show that the mean relative speed of molecules in a gas is related to the mean speed. When the molecules are moving in the same direction, the mean relative speed is zero; it is 2v when the molecules are approaching each other. A typical mean direction of approach is from the side, and the mean speed of approach is then 21/2 v. The last direction of approach is the most characteristic, so the mean speed of approach can be expected to be about 21/2 v. This value is confirmed by more detailed calculation. v v 21/2 v 21/2 v0 2v Source Selector Detector Fig. 21.8 A velocity selector. The molecules are produced in the source (which may be an oven with a small hole in one wall), and travel in a beam towards the rotating channels. Only if the speed of a molecule is such as to carry it along the channel that rotates into its path will it reach the detector. Thus, the number of slow molecules can be counted by rotating the cylinder slowly, and the number of fast molecules counted by rotating the cylinder rapidly. Synoptic table 21.1* Collision cross- sections s/nm2 C6H6 0.88 CO2 0.52 He 0.21 N2 0.43 * More values are given in the Data section. Miss Hit d d c trel D Area, s Fig. 21.9 In an interval ∆t, a molecule of diameter d sweeps out a tube of radius d and length Krel∆t. As it does so it encounters other molecules with centres that lie within the tube, and each such encounter counts as one collision. In reality, the tube is not straight, but changes direction at each collision. Nevertheless, the volume swept out is the same, and this straightened version of the tube can be used as a basis of the calculation. 754 21 MOLECULES IN MOTION volume of the tube multiplied by the number density N = N/V, and is NσKrel∆t. The number of hits scored in the interval ∆t is equal to this number, so the number of collisions divided by the time interval, is NσKrel. The expression in terms of the pressure of the gas is obtained by using the perfect gas equation to write N = = = = Equation 21.11a shows that, at constant volume, the collision frequency increases with increasing temperature. The reason for this increase is that the relative mean speed increases with temperature (eqns 21.9 and 21.10). Equation 21.11b shows that, at constant temperature, the collision frequency is proportional to the pressure. Such a proportionality is plausible, for the greater the pressure, the greater the number density of molecules in the sample, and the rate at which they encounter one another is greater even though their average speed remains the same. For an N2 molecule in a sample at 1 atm and 25°C, z ≈ 5 × 109 s−1 , so a given molecule collides about 5 × 109 times each second. We are beginning to appreciate the timescale of events in gases. (c) The mean free path Once we have the collision frequency, we can calculate the mean free path, λ (lambda), the average distance a molecule travels between collisions. If a molecule collides with a frequency z, it spends a time 1/z in free flight between collisions, and therefore travels a distance (1/z)K. It follows that the mean free path is λ = (21.12) Substitution of the expression for z in eqn 21.11b gives λ = (21.13) Doubling the pressure reduces the mean free path by half. A typical mean free path in nitrogen gas at 1 atm is 70 nm, or about 103 molecular diameters. Although the temperature appears in eqn 21.13, in a sample of constant volume, the pressure is proportional to T, so T/p remains constant when the temperature is increased. Therefore, the mean free path is independent of the temperature in a sample of gas in a container of fixed volume. The distance between collisions is determined by the number of molecules present in the given volume, not by the speed at which they travel. In summary, a typical gas (N2 or O2) at 1 atm and 25°C can be thought of as a collection of molecules travelling with a mean speed of about 500 m s−1 . Each molecule makes a collision within about 1 ns, and between collisions it travels about 103 molecular diameters. The kinetic model of gases is valid (and the gas behaves nearly perfectly) if the diameter of the molecules is much smaller than the mean free path (d << λ), for then the molecules spend most of their time far from one another. IMPACT ON ASTROPHYSICS I21.1 The Sun as a ball of perfect gas The kinetic model of gases is valid when the size of the particles is negligible compared with their mean free path. It may seem absurd, therefore, to expect the kinetic model and, as a consequence, the perfect gas law, to be applicable to the dense matter of stellar interiors. In the Sun, for instance, the density at its centre is 1.50 times that of liquid water and comparable to that of water about half way to its surface. However, kT 21/2 σp K z p kT pNA RT nNA V N V 21.2 COLLISIONS WITH WALLS AND SURFACES 755 we have to realize that the state of matter is that of a plasma, in which the electrons have been stripped from the atoms of hydrogen and helium that make up the bulk of the matter of stars. As a result, the particles making up the plasma have diameters comparable to those of nuclei, or about 10 fm. Therefore, a mean free path of only 0.1 pm satisfies the criterion for the validity of the kinetic theory and the perfect gas law. We can therefore use pV = nRT as the equation of state for the stellar interior. As for any perfect gas, the pressure in the interior of the Sun is related to the mass density, ρ = m/V, by p = ρRT/M. Atoms are stripped of their electrons in the interior of stars so, if we suppose that the interior consists of ionized hydrogen atoms, the mean molar mass is one-half the molar mass of hydrogen, or 0.5 g mol−1 (the mean of the molar mass of H+ and e− , the latter being virtually 0). Half way to the centre of the Sun, the temperature is 3.6 MK and the mass density is 1.20 g cm−3 (slightly denser than water); so the pressure there works out as 7.2 × 1013 Pa, or about 720 million atmospheres. We can combine this result with the expression for the pressure from the kinetic model (eqn 21.1). Because the total kinetic energy of the particles is EK = 1 –2Nmc2 , we can write p = 2 –3EK/V. That is, the pressure of the plasma is related to the kinetic energy density, ρK = EK/V, the kinetic energy of the molecules in a region divided by the volume of the region, by p = 2 –3ρK. It follows that the kinetic energy density half way to the centre of the Sun is about 0.11 GJ cm−3 . In contrast, on a warm day (25°C) on Earth, the (translational) kinetic energy density of our atmosphere is only 0.15 J cm−3 . 21.2 Collisions with walls and surfaces Thekeyresultforaccountingfortransportinthegasphaseistherateatwhichmolecules strike an area (which may be an imaginary area embedded in the gas, or part of a real wall). The collision flux, ZW, is the number of collisions with the area in a given time interval divided by the area and the duration of the interval. The collision frequency, the number of hits per second, is obtained by multiplication of the collision flux by the area of interest. We show in the Justification below that the collision flux is ZW = (21.14)° When p = 100 kPa (1.00 bar) and T = 300 K, ZW ≈ 3 × 1023 cm−2 s−1 . Justification 21.4 The collision flux Consider a wall of area A perpendicular to the x-axis (as in Fig. 21.2). If a molecule has vx > 0 (that is, it is travelling in the direction of positive x), then it will strike the wall within an interval ∆t if it lies within a distance vx∆t of the wall. Therefore, all molecules in the volume Avx∆t, and with positive x-component of velocities, will strike the wall in the interval ∆t. The total number of collisions in this interval is therefore the volume Avx∆t multiplied by the number density, N , of molecules. However, to take account of the presence of a range of velocities in the sample, we must sum the result over all the positive values of vx weighted by the probability distribution of velocities (eqn 21.6): Number of collisions = N A∆tΎ ∞ 0 vx f(vx)dx The collision flux is the number of collisions divided by A and ∆t, so ZW = N Ύ ∞ 0 vx f(vx)dx p (2πmkT)1/2 756 21 MOLECULES IN MOTION Then, using the velocity distribution in eqn 21.6, Ύ ∞ 0 vx f(vx)dvx = 1/2 Ύ ∞ 0 vxe−mv2 x/2kT dvx = 1/2 where we have used the standard integral Ύ ∞ 0 xe−ax2 dx = Therefore, ZW = N 1/2 = 1–4KN (21.15)° where we have used eqn 21.7 in the form K = (8kT/πm)1/2 , which implies that 1–4K = (kT/2πm)1/2 . Substitution of N = nNA/V = p/kT gives eqn 21.14. 21.3 The rate of effusion The essential empirical observations on effusion are summarized by Graham’s law of effusion, which states that the rate of effusion is inversely proportional to the square root of the molar mass. The basis of this result is that, as remarked above, the mean speed of molecules is inversely proportional to M1/2 , so the rate at which they strike the area of the hole is also inversely proportional to M1/2 . However, by using the expression for the rate of collisions, we can obtain a more detailed expression for the rate of effusion and hence use effusion data more effectively. When a gas at a pressure p and temperature T is separated from a vacuum by a small hole, the rate of escape of its molecules is equal to the rate at which they strike the area of the hole (which is given by eqn 21.14). Therefore, for a hole of area A0, Rate of effusion = ZWA = = (21.16)° where, in the last step, we have used R = NAk and M = mNA. This rate is inversely proportional to M1/2 , in accord with Graham’s law. Equation 21.16 is the basis of the Knudsen method for the determination of the vapour pressures of liquids and solids, particularly of substances with very low vapour pressures. Thus, if the vapour pressure of a sample is p, and it is enclosed in a cavity with a small hole, then the rate of loss of mass from the container is proportional to p. Example 21.2 Calculating the vapour pressure from a mass loss Caesium (m.p. 29°C, b.p. 686°C) was introduced into a container and heated to 500°C. When a hole of diameter 0.50 mm was opened in the container for 100 s, a mass loss of 385 mg was measured. Calculate the vapour pressure of liquid caesium at 500 K. Method The pressure of vapour is constant inside the container despite the effusion of atoms because the hot liquid metal replenishes the vapour. The rate of effusion is therefore constant, and given by eqn 21.16. To express the rate in terms of mass, multiply the number of atoms that escape by the mass of each atom. Answer The mass loss ∆m in an interval ∆t is related to the collision flux by ∆m = ZWA0m∆t pA0NA (2πMRT)1/2 pA0 (2πmkT)1/2 D F kT 2πm A C 1 2a D F kT 2πm A C D F m 2πkT A C 21.4 TRANSPORT PROPERTIES OF A PERFECT GAS 757 z N dN dz < 0 J 0> Fig. 21.10 The flux of particles down a concentration gradient. Fick’s first law states that the flux of matter (the number of particles passing through an imaginary window in a given interval divided by the area of the window and the duration of the interval) is proportional to the density gradient at that point. where A0 is the area of the hole and m is the mass of one atom. It follows that ZW = Because ZW is related to the pressure by eqn 21.14, we can write p = 1/2 Because M = 132.9 g mol−1 , substitution of the data gives p = 11 kPa (using 1 Pa = 1 N m−2 = 1 J m−1 ), or 83 Torr. Self-test 21.2 How long would it take 1.0 g of Cs atoms to effuse out of the oven under the same conditions? [260 s] 21.4 Transport properties of a perfect gas Transport properties are commonly expressed in terms of a number of ‘phenomenological’ equations, or equations that are empirical summaries of experimental observations. These phenomenological equations apply to all kinds of properties and media. In the following sections, we introduce the equations for the general case and then show how to calculate the parameters that appear in them. (a) The phenomenological equations The rate of migration of a property is measured by its flux, J, the quantity of that property passing through a given area in a given time interval divided by the area and the duration of the interval. If matter is flowing (as in diffusion), we speak of a matterflux of so many molecules per square metre per second; if the property is energy (as in thermal conduction), then we speak of the energy flux and express it in joules per square metre per second, and so on. Experimental observations on transport properties show that the flux of a property is usually proportional to the first derivative of some other related property. For example, the flux of matter diffusing parallel to the z-axis of a container is found to be proportional to the first derivative of the concentration: J(matter) ∝ (21.17) where N is the number density of particles with units number per metre cubed (m−3 ). The SI units of J are number per metre squared per second (m−2 s−1 ). The proportionality of the flux of matter to the concentration gradient is sometimes called Fick’s first lawofdiffusion: the law implies that, if the concentration varies steeply with position, then diffusion will be fast. There is no net flux if the concentration is uniform (dN /dz = 0). Similarly, the rate of thermal conduction (the flux of the energy associated with thermal motion) is found to be proportional to the temperature gradient: J(energy) ∝ (21.18) The SI units of this flux are joules per metre squared per second (J m−2 s−1 ). A positive value of J signifies a flux towards positive z; a negative value of J signifies a flux towards negative z. Because matter flows down a concentration gradient, from high concentration to low concentration, J is positive if dN /dz is negative (Fig. 21.10). dT dz dN dz ∆m A0∆t D F 2πRT M A C ∆m A0m∆t 758 21 MOLECULES IN MOTION Therefore, the coefficient of proportionality in eqn 21.18 must be negative, and we write it −D: J(matter) = −D (21.19) The constant D is the called the diffusioncoefficient; its SI units are metre squared per second (m2 s−1 ). Energy migrates down a temperature gradient, and the same reasoning leads to J(energy) = −κ (21.20) where κ is the coefficient of thermal conductivity. The SI units of κ are joules per kelvin per metre per second (J K−1 m−1 s−1 ). Some experimental values are given in Table 21.2. To see the connection between the flux of momentum and the viscosity, consider a fluid in a state of Newtonian flow, which can be imagined as occurring by a series of layers moving past one another (Fig. 21.11). The layer next to the wall of the vessel is stationary, and the velocity of successive layers varies linearly with distance, z, from the wall. Molecules ceaselessly move between the layers and bring with them the x-component of linear momentum they possessed in their original layer. A layer is retarded by molecules arriving from a more slowly moving layer because they have a low momentum in the x-direction. A layer is accelerated by molecules arriving from a more rapidly moving layer. We interpret the net retarding effect as the fluid’s viscosity. Because the retarding effect depends on the transfer of the x-component of linear momentum into the layer of interest, the viscosity depends on the flux of this xcomponent in the z-direction. The flux of the x-component of momentum is proportional to dvx/dz because there is no net flux when all the layers move at the same velocity. We can therefore write J(x-component of momentum) = −η (21.21) The constant of proportionality, η, is the coefficient of viscosity (or simply ‘the viscosity’). Its units are kilograms per metre per second (kg m−1 s−1 ). Viscosities are often reported in poise (P), where 1 P = 10−1 kg m−1 s−1 . Some experimental values are given in Table 21.2. (b) The transport parameters As shown in Further information 21.1 and summarized in Table 21.3, the kinetic model leads to expressions for the diffusional parameters of a perfect gas. dvx dz dT dz dN dz Synoptic table 21.2* Transport properties of gases at 1 atm k/(J K−1 m−1 s−1 ) h/(mP)† 273 K 273 K 293 K Ar 0.0163 210 223 CO2 0.0145 136 147 He 0.1442 187 196 N2 0.0240 166 176 * More values are given in the Data section. † 1 µP = 10−7 kg m−1 s−1 . Wall Bring high -momentumx Bring low -momentumx x z Fig. 21.11 The viscosity of a fluid arises from the transport of linear momentum. In this illustration the fluid is undergoing laminar flow, and particles bring their initial momentum when they enter a new layer. If they arrive with high x-component of momentum they accelerate the layer; if with low x-component of momentum they retard the layer. Table 21.3 Transport properties of perfect gases Property Transported quantity Simple kinetic theory Units Diffusion Matter D = 1 –3λK m2 s−1 Thermal conductivity Energy κ = 1 –3λKCV,m[A] J K−1 m−1 s−1 = Viscosity Linear momentum η = 1 –3λKmN kg m−1 s−1 = mK 3 2σ KC N V,m A3 2σ 21.4 TRANSPORT PROPERTIES OF A PERFECT GAS 759 The diffusion coefficient is D = 1 –3λK (21.22)° As usual, we need to consider the significance of this expression: 1 The mean free path, λ, decreases as the pressure is increased (eqn 21.13), so D decreaseswithincreasingpressureand,asaresult,thegasmoleculesdiffusemoreslowly. 2 The mean speed, K, increases with the temperature (eqn 21.7), so D also increases with temperature. As a result, molecules in a hot sample diffuse more quickly than those in a cool sample (for a given concentration gradient). 3 Because the mean free path increases when the collision cross-section of the molecules decreases (eqn 21.13), the diffusion coefficient is greater for small molecules than for large molecules. Similarly, according to the kinetic model of gases, the thermal conductivity of a perfect gas A having molar concentration [A] is given by the expression κ = 1 –3λKCV,m[A] (21.23)° where CV,m is the molar heat capacity at constant volume. To interpret this expression, we note that: 1 Because λ is inversely proportional to the pressure, and hence inversely proportional to the molar concentration of the gas, the thermal conductivity is independent of the pressure. 2 The thermal conductivity is greater for gases with a high heat capacity because a given temperature gradient then corresponds to a greater energy gradient. The physical reason for the pressure independence of κ is that the thermal conductivity can be expected to be large when many molecules are available to transport the energy, but the presence of so many molecules limits their mean free path and they cannot carry the energy over a great distance. These two effects balance. The thermal conductivity is indeed found experimentally to be independent of the pressure, except when the pressure is very low, when κ ∝ p. At low pressures λ exceeds the dimensions of the apparatus, and the distance over which the energy is transported is determined by the size of the container and not by the other molecules present. The flux is still proportional to the number of carriers, but the length of the journey no longer depends on λ, so κ ∝ [A], which implies that κ ∝ p. Finally, the kinetic model leads to the following expression for the viscosity (see Further information 21.1): η = 1 –3MλK[A] (21.24)° where [A] is the molar concentration of the gas molecules and M is their molar mass. We can interpret this expression as follows: 1 Because λ ∝ 1/p (eqn 21.13) and [A] ∝ p, it follows that η ∝ K, independent of p. That is, the viscosity is independent of the pressure 2 Because K ∝ T1/2 (eqn 21.7), η ∝ T1/2 . That is, the viscosity of a gas increases with temperature. The physical reason for the pressure-independence of the viscosity is the same as for the thermal conductivity: more molecules are available to transport the momentum, but they carry it less far on account of the decrease in mean free path. The increase of viscosity with temperature is explained when we remember that at high temperatures the molecules travel more quickly, so the flux of momentum is greater. By contrast, as 760 21 MOLECULES IN MOTION 10/(kgms) 511-- h 0 1 2 3 -3 -2 -1 0 1 2 log ( /atm)p 0 2 4 6 8 0 500 1000 1500 2000 T/K (b) 1 atm (a) 300 K 10/(kgms) 511-- h 2500 hh Fig. 21.12 The experimental results for (a) the pressure dependence of the viscosity of argon, and (b) its temperature dependence. The blue line in the latter is the calculated value. Fitting the observed and calculating curves is one way of determining the collision cross-section. we shall see in Section 21.6, the viscosity of a liquid decreases with increase in temperature because intermolecular interactions must be overcome. There are two main techniques for measuring viscosities of gases. One technique depends on the rate of damping of the torsional oscillations of a disc hanging in the gas. The half-life of the decay of the oscillation depends on the viscosity and the design of the apparatus, and the apparatus needs to be calibrated. The other method is based on Poiseuille’s formula for the rate of flow of a fluid through a tube of radius r: = (21.25) where V is the volume flowing, p1 and p2 are the pressures at each end of the tube of length l, and p0 is the pressure at which the volume is measured. Such measurements confirm that the viscosities of gases are independent of pressure over a wide range. For instance, the results for argon from 10−3 atm to 102 atm are shown in Fig. 21.12, and we see that η is constant from about 0.01 atm to 20 atm. The measurements also confirm (to a lesser extent) the T1/2 dependence. The blue line in the illustration shows the calculated values using σ = 22 × 10−20 m2 , implying a collision diameter of 260 pm, in contrast to the van der Waals diameter of 335 pm obtained from the density of the solid. The agreement is not too bad, considering the simplicity of the model, especially the neglect of intermolecular forces. Illustration 21.1 Using the Poiseuille formula In a Poiseuille flow experiment to measure the viscosity of air at 298 K, the sample was allowed to flow through a tube of length 100 cm and internal diameter 1.00 mm. The high-pressure end was at 765 Torr and the low-pressure end was at 760 Torr. The volume was measured at the latter pressure. In 100 s, 90.2 cm3 of air passed through the tube. The viscosity of air at 298 K is found by reorganizing the Poiseuille formula, eqn 21.25, into η = and substituting the data (after converting the pressures to pascals by using 1 Torr = 133.3 Pa): η = = 1.82 × 10−4 kg m−1 s−1 where we have used 1 Pa = 1 kg m−1 s−2 . The kinetic model expression gives η = 1.4 × 10−5 kg m−1 s−1 , so the agreement is reasonably good. Viscosities are commonly expressed in centipoise (cP) or (for gases) micropoise (µP), the conversion being 1 cP = 10−3 kg m−1 s−1 ; the viscosity of air at 20°C is about 180 µP. Self-test 21.3 What volume would be collected if the pressure gradient were doubled, other conditions remaining constant? [181 cm3 ] D F 9.02 × 10−5 m3 100 s A C {(765 × 133.3 Pa)2 − (760 × 133.3 Pa)2 } × π × (5.00 × 10−4 m)4 16 × (1.00 × 10−1 m) × (760 × 133.3 Pa) × (p2 1 − p2 2)πr4 16lp0(dV/dt) (p2 1 − p2 2)πr4 16lηp0 dV dt 21.6 THE CONDUCTIVITIES OF ELECTROLYTE SOLUTIONS 761 Molecular motion in liquids We outlined what is currently known about the structure of simple liquids in Section 17.6. Here we consider a particularly simple type of motion through a liquid, that of an ion, and see that the information that motion provides can be used to infer the behaviour of uncharged species too. 21.5 Experimental results The motion of molecules in liquids can be studied experimentally by a variety of methods. Relaxation time measurements in NMR and EPR (Chapter 15) can be interpreted in terms of the mobilities of the molecules, and have been used to show that big molecules in viscous fluids typically rotate in a series of small (about 5°) steps, whereas small molecules in nonviscous fluids typically jump through about 1 radian (57°) in each step. Another important technique is inelastic neutron scattering, in which the energy neutrons collect or discard as they pass through a sample is interpreted in terms of the motion of its particles. The same technique is used to examine the internal dynamics of macromolecules. More mundane than these experiments are viscosity measurements (Table 21.4). For a molecule to move in a liquid, it must acquire at least a minimum energy to escape from its neighbours. The probability that a molecule has at least an energy Ea is proportional to e−Ea/RT , so the mobility of the molecules in the liquid should follow this type of temperature dependence. Because the coefficient of viscosity, η, is inversely proportional to the mobility of the particles, we should expect that η ∝ eEa/RT (21.26) (Note the positive sign of the exponent.) This expression implies that the viscosity should decrease sharply with increasing temperature. Such a variation is found experimentally, at least over reasonably small temperature ranges (Fig. 21.13). The activation energy typical of viscosity is comparable to the mean potential energy of intermolecular interactions. One problem with the interpretation of viscosity measurements is that the change in density of the liquid as it is heated makes a pronounced contribution to the temperature variation of the viscosity. Thus, the temperature dependence of viscosity at constant volume, when the density is constant, is much less than that at constant pressure. The intermolecular interactions between the molecules of the liquid govern the magnitude of Ea, but the problem of calculating it is immensely difficult and still largely unsolved. At low temperatures, the viscosity of water decreases as the pressure is increased. This behaviour is consistent with the rupture of hydrogen bonds. 21.6 The conductivities of electrolyte solutions Further insight into the nature of molecular motion can be obtained by studying the motion of ions in solution, for ions can be dragged through the solvent by the application of a potential difference between two electrodes immersed in the sample. By studying the transport of charge through electrolyte solutions it is possible to build up a picture of the events that occur in them and, in some cases, to extrapolate the conclusions to species that have zero charge, that is, to neutral molecules. (a) Conductance and conductivity The fundamental measurement used to study the motion of ions is that of the electrical resistance, R, of the solution. The conductance, G, of a solution is the inverse of its Synoptic table 21.4* Viscosities of liquids at 298 K h/(10−3 kg m−1 s−1 ) Benzene 0.601 Mercury 1.55 Propane 0.224 Water† 0.891 * More values are given in the Data section. † The viscosity of water corresponds to 0.891 cP. 0 0.4 0.8 1.2 1.6 10/(kgms) 311-- h 0 20 40 60 80 100 q/°C 2.0 h q Fig. 21.13 The experimental temperature dependence of the viscosity of water. As the temperature is increased, more molecules are able to escape from the potential wells provided by their neighbours, and so the liquid becomes more fluid. A plot of ln η against 1/T is a straight line (over a small range) with positive slope. 762 21 MOLECULES IN MOTION resistance R: G = 1/R. As resistance is expressed in ohms, Ω, the conductance of a sample is expressed in Ω−1 . The reciprocal ohm used to be called the mho, but its official designation is now the siemens, S, and 1 S = 1 Ω−1 = 1 C V−1 s−1 . The conductance of a sample decreases with its length l and increases with its cross-sectional area A. We therefore write G = (21.27) where κ is the conductivity. With the conductance in siemens and the dimensions in metres, it follows that the SI units of κ are siemens per metre (S m−1 ). The conductivity of a solution depends on the number of ions present, and it is normal to introduce the molar conductivity, Λm, which is defined as Λm = [21.28] where c is the molar concentration of the added electrolyte. The SI unit of molar conductivity is siemens metre-squared per mole (S m2 mol−1 ), and typical values are about 10 mS m2 mol−1 (where 1 mS = 10−3 S). The molar conductivity is found to vary with the concentration. One reason for this variation is that the number of ions in the solution might not be proportional to the concentration of the electrolyte. For instance, the concentration of ions in a solution of a weak acid depends on the concentration of the acid in a complicated way, and doubling the concentration of the acid added does not double the number of ions. Secondly, because ions interact strongly with one another, the conductivity of a solution is not exactly proportional to the number of ions present. The concentration dependence of molar conductivities indicates that there are two classes of electrolyte. The characteristic of a strong electrolyte is that its molar conductivity depends only slightly on the molar concentration (and in general decreases slightly as the concentration is increased, Fig. 21.14). The characteristic of a weak electrolyte is that its molar conductivity is normal at concentrations close to zero, but falls sharply to low values as the concentration increases. The classification depends on the solvent employed as well as the solute: lithium chloride, for example, is a strong electrolyte in water but a weak electrolyte in propanone. (b) Strong electrolytes Strong electrolytes are substances that are virtually fully ionized in solution, and include ionic solids and strong acids. As a result of their complete ionization, the concentration of ions in solution is proportional to the concentration of strong electrolyte added. In an extensive series of measurements during the nineteenth century, Friedrich Kohlrausch showed that at low concentrations the molar conductivities of strong electrolytes vary linearly with the square root of the concentration: Λm = Λ°m − K c1/2 (21.29) This variation is called Kohlrausch’s law. The constant Λ°m is the limiting molar conductivity, the molar conductivity in the limit of zero concentration (when the ions are effectively infinitely far apart and do not interact with one another). The constant K is found to depend more on the stoichiometry of the electrolyte (that is, whether it is of the form MA, or M2A, etc.) than on its specific identity. In due course we shall see that the c1/2 dependence arises from interactions between ions: when charge is conducted ionically, ions of one charge are moving past the ions of interest and retard its progress. κ c κA l Lm/(Scmmol) 21- 0 40 80 120 160 390.5 KCl CH COOH3 149.8 0 20 40 60 80 100 c/(mmol dm ) -3 L Fig. 21.14 The concentration dependence of the molar conductivities of (a) a typical strong electrolyte (aqueous potassium chloride) and (b) a typical weak electrolyte (aqueous acetic acid). 21.6 THE CONDUCTIVITIES OF ELECTROLYTE SOLUTIONS 763 Synoptic table 21.5* Limiting ionic conductivities in water at 298 K l/(mS m2 mol−1 ) l/(mS m2 mol−1 ) H+ 34.96 OH− 19.91 Na+ 5.01 Cl− 7.63 K+ 7.35 Br− 7.81 Zn2+ 10.56 SO4 2− 16.00 * More values are given in the Data section. Comment 21.2 It will be familiar from introductory chemistry that a Brønsted acid is a proton donor and a Brønsted base is a proton acceptor. In eqn 21.31, HA(aq) is a Brønsted acid and H2O(l) is a Brønsted base. The equilibrium constant for the reaction between HA(aq) and H2O(l) is the acidity constant Ka of HA. Acids with Ka < 1, indicating only a small extent of deprotonation in water, are classified as weak acids. Kohlrausch was also able to establish experimentally that Λ°m can be expressed as the sum of contributions from its individual ions. If the limiting molar conductivity of the cations is denoted λ+ and that of the anions λ−, then his law of the independent migration of ions states that Λ°m = ν+λ+ + ν−λ− (21.30)° where ν+ and ν− are the numbers of cations and anions per formula unit of electrolyte (for example, ν+ = ν− = 1 for HCl, NaCl, and CuSO4, but ν+ = 1, ν− = 2 for MgCl2). This simple result, which can be understood on the grounds that the ions migrate independently in the limit of zero concentration, lets us predict the limiting molar conductivity of any strong electrolyte from the data in Table 21.5. Illustration 21.2 Calculating a limiting molar conductivity The limiting molar conductivity of BaCl2 in water at 298 K is Λm° = (12.72 + 2 × 7.63) mS m2 mol−1 = 27.98 mS m2 mol−1 (c) Weak electrolytes Weak electrolytes are not fully ionized in solution. They include weak Brønsted acids and bases, such as CH3COOH and NH3. The marked concentration dependence of their molar conductivities arises from the displacement of the equilibrium HA(aq) + H2O(l) 5 H3O+ (aq) + A− (aq) Ka = (21.31) towards products at low molar concentrations. The conductivity depends on the number of ions in the solution, and therefore on the degree of ionization, α, of the electrolyte; when referring to weak acids, we speak instead of the degreeofdeprotonation. It is defined so that, for the acid HA at a molar concentration c, at equilibrium [H3O+ ] = αc [A− ] = αc [HA] = (1 − α)c (21.32) If we ignore activity coefficients, the acidity constant, Ka, is approximately Ka = (21.33)° from which it follows that α = 1 + 1/2 − 1 (21.34)° 5 6 7 D F 4c Ka A C 1 2 3 Ka 2c α2 c 1 − α aH3O+aA− aHA 764 21 MOLECULES IN MOTION 1/mL 1/ °mL c mLL L L Fig. 21.15 The graph used to determine the limiting value of the molar conductivity of a solution by extrapolation to zero concentration. The acid is fully deprotonated at infinite dilution, and its molar conductivity is then Λ°m. Because only a fraction α is actually present as ions in the actual solution, the measured molar conductivity Λm is given by Λm = αΛ°m (21.35)° with α given by eqn 21.34. Illustration 21.3 Using molar conductivity data to calculate an acidity constant The molar conductivity of 0.0100 m CH3COOH(aq) at 298 K is Λm = 1.65 mS m2 mol−1 . The degree of deprotonation, α, is calculated from eqn 21.35 with Λ°m = 39.05 mS cm2 mol−1 (Table 21.5). It follows that α = 0.0423. The acidity constant, Ka, is calculated by substitution of α into eqn 21.33, which gives Ka = 1.9 × 10−5 . Self-test 21.4 The molar conductivity of 0.0250 m HCOOH(aq) is 4.61 mS m2 mol−1 . Determine the pKa = −log Ka of the acid. [3.44] Once we know Ka, we can use eqns 21.34 and 21.35 to predict the concentration dependence of the molar conductivity. The result agrees quite well with the experimental curve in Fig. 21.14. More usefully, we can use the concentration dependence of Λm in measurements of the limiting molar conductance. First, we rearrange eqn 21.33 into = 1 + (21.36)° Then, by using eqn 21.35, we obtain Ostwald’s dilution law: = + (21.37)° This equation implies that, if 1/Λm is plotted against cΛm, then the intercept at c = 0 will be 1/Λ°m (Fig. 21.15). 21.7 The mobilities of ions To interpret conductivity measurements we need to know why ions move at different rates, why they have different molar conductivities, and why the molar conductivities of strong electrolytes decrease with the square root of the molar concentration. The central idea in this section is that, although the motion of an ion remains largely random, the presence of an electric field biases its motion, and the ion undergoes net migration through the solution. (a) The drift speed When the potential difference between two electrodes a distance l apart is ∆φ, the ions in the solution between them experience a uniform electric field of magnitude E = (21.38) In such a field, an ion of charge ze experiences a force of magnitude F = zeE = (21.39) ze∆φ l ∆φ l Λmc Ka(Λ°m)2 1 Λ°m 1 Λm αc Ka 1 α 21.7 THE MOBILITIES OF IONS 765 (In this chapter we disregard the sign of the charge number and so avoid notational complications.) A cation responds to the application of the field by accelerating towards the negative electrode and an anion responds by accelerating towards the positive electrode. However, this acceleration is short-lived. As the ion moves through the solvent it experiences a frictional retarding force, Ffric, proportional to its speed. If we assume that the Stokes formula (eqn 19.12) for a sphere of radius a and speed s applies even on a microscopic scale (and independent evidence from magnetic resonance suggests that it often gives at least the right order of magnitude), then we can write this retarding force as Ffric = fs f = 6πηa (21.40) The two forces act in opposite directions, and the ions quickly reach a terminal speed, the driftspeed, when the accelerating force is balanced by the viscous drag. The net force is zero when s = (21.41) It follows that the drift speed of an ion is proportional to the strength of the applied field. We write s = uE [21.42] where u is called the mobility of the ion (Table 21.6). Comparison of eqns 21.41 and 21.42 and use of eqn 21.40 shows that u = = (21.43) Illustration 21.4 Calculating an ionic mobility For an order of magnitude estimate we can take z = 1 and a the radius of an ion such as Cs+ (which might be typical of a smaller ion plus its hydration sphere), which is 170 pm. For the viscosity, we use η = 1.0 cP (1.0 × 10−3 kg m−1 s−1 , Table 21.4). Then u ≈ 5 × 10−8 m2 V−1 s−1 . This value means that, when there is a potential difference of 1 V across a solution of length 1 cm (so E = 100 V m−1 ), the drift speed is typically about 5 µm s−1 . That speed might seem slow, but not when expressed on a molecular scale, for it corresponds to an ion passing about 104 solvent molecules per second. ze 6πηa ze f zeE f Synoptic table 21.6* Ionic mobilities in water at 298 K u/(10−8 m2 s−1 V−1 ) u/(10−8 m2 s−1 V−1 ) H+ 36.23 OH− 20.64 Na+ 5.19 Cl− 7.91 K+ 7.62 Br− 8.09 Zn2+ 5.47 SO4 2− 8.29 * More values are given in the Data section. 766 21 MOLECULES IN MOTION Because the drift speed governs the rate at which charge is transported, we might expect the conductivity to decrease with increasing solution viscosity and ion size. Experiments confirm these predictions for bulky ions (such as R4N+ and RCO2 − ) but not for small ions. For example, the molar conductivities of the alkali metal ions increase from Li+ to Cs+ (Table 21.6) even though the ionic radii increase. The paradox is resolved when we realize that the radius a in the Stokes formula is the hydrodynamic radius (or ‘Stokes radius’) of the ion, its effective radius in the solution taking into account all the H2O molecules it carries in its hydration sphere. Small ions give rise to stronger electric fields than large ones (the electric field at the surface of a sphere of radius r is proportional to ze/r2 and it follows that the smaller the radius the stronger the field), so small ions are more extensively solvated than big ions. Thus, an ion of small ionic radius may have a large hydrodynamic radius because it drags many solvent molecules through the solution as it migrates. The hydrating H2O molecules are often very labile, however, and NMR and isotope studies have shown that the exchange between the coordination sphere of the ion and the bulk solvent is very rapid. The proton, although it is very small, has a very high molar conductivity (Table 21.6)! Proton and 17 O-NMR show that the times characteristic of protons hopping from one molecule to the next are about 1.5 ps, which is comparable to the time that inelastic neutron scattering shows it takes a water molecule to reorientate through about 1 rad (1 to 2 ps). According to the Grotthuss mechanism, there is an effective motion of a proton that involves the rearrangement of bonds in a group of water molecules. However, the actual mechanism is still highly contentious. Attention now focuses on the H9O4 + unit, in which the nearly trigonal planar H3O+ ion is linked to three strongly solvating H2O molecules. This cluster of atoms is itself hydrated, but the hydrogen bonds in the secondary sphere are weaker than in the primary sphere. It is envisaged that the rate-determining step is the cleavage of one of the weaker hydrogen bonds of this secondary sphere (Fig. 21.16a). After this bond cleavage has taken place, and the released molecule has rotated through a few degrees (a process that takes about 1 ps), there is a rapid adjustment of bond lengths and angles in the remaining cluster, to form an H5O2 + cation of structure H2O ···H+ ···OH2 (Fig. 21.16b). Shortly after this reorganization has occurred, a new H9O4 + cluster forms as other molecules rotate into a position where they can become members of a secondary hydration sphere, but now the positive charge is located one molecule to the right of its initial location (Fig. 21.16c). According to this model, there is no coordinated motion of a proton along a chain of molecules, simply a very rapid hopping between neighbouring sites, with a low activation energy. The model is consistent with the observation that the molar conductivity of protons increases as the pressure is raised, for increasing pressure ruptures the hydrogen bonds in water. The mobility of NH4 + is also anomalous and presumably occurs by an analogous mechanism. (b) Mobility and conductivity Ionic mobilities provide a link between measurable and theoretical quantities. As a first step we establish in the Justification below the following relation between an ion’s mobility and its molar conductivity: λ = zuF (21.44)° where F is Faraday’s constant (F = NAe). Comment 21.3 The H3O+ ion is trigonal pyramidal in the gas phase but nearly planar in water. (a) (b) (c) + + + Fig. 21.16 The mechanism of conduction by hydrogen ions in water as proposed by N. Agmon (Chem. Phys. Letts. 244, 456 (1995)). Proton transfer between neighbouring molecules occurs when one molecule rotates into such a position that an O-H···O hydrogen bond can flip into being an O···H-O hydrogen bond. See text for a description of the steps. 21.7 THE MOBILITIES OF IONS 767 Justification 21.5 The relation between ionic mobility and molar conductivity To keep the calculation simple, we ignore signs in the following, and concentrate on the magnitudes of quantities: the direction of ion flux can always be decided by common sense. Consider a solution of a fully dissociated strong electrolyte at a molar concentration c. Let each formula unit give rise to ν+ cations of charge z+e and ν− anions of charge z−e. The molar concentration of each type of ion is therefore νc (with ν = ν+ or ν−), and the number density of each type is νcNA. The number of ions of one kind that pass through an imaginary window of area A during an interval ∆t is equal to the number within the distance s∆t (Fig. 21.17), and therefore to the number in the volume s∆tA. (The same sort of argument was used in Section 21.1 in the discussion of the pressure of a gas.) The number of ions of that kind in this volume is equal to s∆tAνcNA. The flux through the window (the number of this type of ion passing through the window divided by the area of the window and the duration of the interval) is therefore J(ions) = = sνcNA Each ion carries a charge ze, so the flux of charge is J(charge) = zsνceNA = zsνcF Because s = uE, the flux is J(charge) = zuνcFE The current, I, through the window due to the ions we are considering is the charge flux times the area: I = JA = zuνcFEA Because the electric field is the potential gradient, ∆φ/l, we can write I = (21.45) Current and potential difference are related by Ohm’s law, ∆φ = IR, so it follows that I = = G∆φ = where we have used eqn 21.27 in the form κ = Gl/A. Note that the proportionality of current to potential difference (I ∝ ∆φ) is another example of a phenomenological flux equation like those introduced in Section 21.4. Comparison of the last two expressions gives κ = zuνcF. Division by the molar concentration of ions, νc, then results in eqn 21.44. Equation 21.44 applies to the cations and to the anions. Therefore, for the solution itself in the limit of zero concentration (when there are no interionic interactions), Λ°m = (z+u+ν+ + z−u−ν−)F (21.46a)° For a symmetrical z:z electrolyte (for example, CuSO4 with z = 2), this equation simplifies to Λ°m = z(u+ + u−)F (21.46b)° κA∆φ l ∆φ R zuνcFA∆φ l s∆tAνcNA A∆t Area, A + s t+ D s t- D Cations Anions Fig. 21.17 In the calculation of the current, all the cations within a distance s+∆t (that is, those in the volume s+A∆t) will pass through the area A. The anions in the corresponding volume the other side of the window will also contribute to the current similarly. 768 21 MOLECULES IN MOTION M X+ N X+ A B C D Time t Time 0 l Area, A c Fig. 21.18 In the moving boundary method for the measurement of transport numbers the distance moved by the boundary is observed as a current is passed. All the M ions in the volume between AB and CD must have passed through CD if the boundary moves from AB to CD. One procedure is to add bromothymol blue indicator to a slightly alkaline solution of the ion of interest and to use a cadmium electrode at the lower end of the vertical tube. The electrode produces Cd2+ ions, which are slow moving and slightly acidic (the hydrated ion is a Brønsted acid), and the boundary is revealed by the colour change of the indicator. Illustration 21.5 Estimating a limiting molar conductivity Earlier, we estimated the typical ionic mobility as 5 × 10−8 m2 V−1 s−1 ; so, with z = 1 for both the cation and anion, we can estimate that a typical limiting molar conductivity should be about 10 mS m2 mol−1 , in accord with experiment. The experimental value for KCl, for instance, is 15 mS m2 mol−1 . (c) Transport numbers The transportnumber, t±, is defined as the fraction of total current carried by the ions of a specified type. For a solution of two kinds of ion, the transport numbers of the cations (t+) and anions (t−) are t± = [21.47] where I± is the current carried by the cation (I+) or anion (I−) and I is the total current through the solution. Because the total current is the sum of the cation and anion currents, it follows that t+ + t− = 1 (21.48) The limitingtransportnumber, t°±, is defined in the same way but for the limit of zero concentration of the electrolyte solution. We shall consider only these limiting values from now on, for that avoids the problem of ionic interactions. The current that can be ascribed to each type of ion is related to the mobility of the ion by eqn 21.45. Hence the relation between t°± and u± is t°± = (21.49a)° However, because z+ν+ = z−ν− for any electrolyte, eqn 21.49a simplifies to t°± = (21.49b)° Moreover, because the ionic conductivities are related to the mobilities by eqn 21.44, it also follows from eqn 21.49b that t°± = = (21.50)° and hence, for each type of ion, ν±λ± = t°±Λ°m (21.51)° Consequently, because there are independent ways of measuring transport numbers of ions, we can determine the individual ionic conductivities and (through eqn 21.44) the ionic mobilities. There are several ways to measure transport numbers (see Further reading). One of the most accurate (and the only one we describe in detail) is the moving boundary method, in which the motion of a boundary between two ionic solutions having a common ion is observed as a current flows. Let MX be the salt of interest and NX a salt giving a denser solution. The solution of NX is called the indicator solution; it occupies the lower part of a vertical tube of cross-sectional area A (Fig. 21.18). The MX solution, which is called the leading ν±λ± Λ°m ν±λ± ν+λ+ + ν−λ− u± u+ + u− z±ν±u± z+ν+u+ + z−ν−u− I± I 21.8 CONDUCTIVITIES AND ION–ION INTERACTIONS 769 solution, occupies the upper part of the tube. There is a sharp boundary between the two solutions. The indicator solution must be denser than the leading solution, and the mobility of the M ions must be greater than that of the N ions. Thus, if any M ions diffuse into the lower solution, they will be pulled upwards more rapidly than the N ions around them, and the boundary will reform. When a current I is passed for a time ∆t, the boundary moves from AB to CD, so all the M ions in the volume between AB and CD must have passed through CD. That number is clANA, so the charge that the M ions transfer through the plane is z+clAeNA. However, the total charge transferred when a current I flows for an interval ∆t is I∆t. Therefore, the fraction due to the motion of the M ions, which is their transport number, is t+ = (21.52) Hence, by measuring the distance moved, the transport number and hence the conductivity and mobility of the ions can be determined. 21.8 Conductivities and ion–ion interactions The remaining problem is to account for the c1/2 dependence of the Kohlrausch law (eqn 21.29). In Section 5.9 we saw something similar: the activity coefficients of ions at low concentrations also depend on c1/2 and depend on their charge type rather than their specific identities. That c1/2 dependence was explained in terms of the properties of the ionic atmosphere around each ion, and we can suspect that the same explanation applies here too. To accommodate the effect of motion, we need to modify the picture of an ionic atmosphere as a spherical haze of charge. Because the ions forming the atmosphere do not adjust to the moving ion immediately, the atmosphere is incompletely formed in front of the moving ion and incompletely decayed behind the ion (Fig. 21.19). The overall effect is the displacement of the centre of charge of the atmosphere a short distance behind the moving ion. Because the two charges are opposite, the result is a retardation of the moving ion. This reduction of the ions’ mobility is called the relaxation effect. A confirmation of the picture is obtained by observing the conductivities of ions at high frequencies, which are greater than at low frequencies: the atmosphere does not have time to follow the rapidly changing direction of motion of the ion, and the effect of the field averages to zero. The ionic atmosphere has another effect on the motion of the ions. We have seen that the moving ion experiences a viscous drag. When the ionic atmosphere is present this drag is enhanced because the ionic atmosphere moves in an opposite direction to the central ion. The enhanced viscous drag, which is called the electrophoretic effect, reduces the mobility of the ions, and hence also reduces their conductivities. The quantitative formulation of these effects is far from simple, but the Debye– Hückel–Onsager theory is an attempt to obtain quantitative expressions at about the same level of sophistication as the Debye–Hückel theory itself. The theory leads to a Kohlrausch-like expression in which K = A + BΛ°m (21.53a) with A = 1/2 B = 1/2 (21.53b) where ε is the electric permittivity of the solvent (Section 18.3) and q = 0.586 for a 1,1electrolyte (Table 21.7). The slopes of the conductivity curves are predicted to depend D F 2 εRT A C qz3 eF 24πεRT D F 2 εRT A C z2 eF2 3πη z+clAF I∆t (a) (b) + + - - - - - - - Fig. 21.19 (a) In the absence of an applied field, the ionic atmosphere is spherically symmetric, but (b) when a field is present it is distorted and the centres of negative and positive charge no longer coincide. The attraction between the opposite charges retards the motion of the central ion. 770 21 MOLECULES IN MOTION on the charge type of the electrolyte, in accord with the Kohlrausch law, and some comparisons between theory and experiment are shown in Fig. 21.20. The agreement is quite good at very low ionic strengths, corresponding to very low molar concentrations (less than about 10−3 M, depending on the charge type). IMPACT ON BIOCHEMISTRY I21.2 Ion channels and ion pumps Controlled transport of molecules and ions across biological membranes is at the heart of a number of key cellular processes, such as the transmission of nerve impulses, the transfer of glucose into red blood cells, and the synthesis of ATP by oxidative phosphorylation (Impact I7.2). Here we examine in some detail the various ways in which ions cross the alien environment of the lipid bilayer. Suppose that a membrane provides a barrier that slows down the transfer of molecules or ions into or out of the cell. We saw in Impact I7.2 that the thermodynamic tendency to transport an ion through the membrane is partially determined by a concentration gradient (more precisely, an activity gradient) across the membrane, which results in a difference in molar Gibbs energy between the inside and the outside of the cell, and a transmembrane potential gradient, which is due to the different potential energy of the ions on each side of the bilayer. There is a tendency, called passive transport, for a species to move down concentration and membrane potential gradients. It is also possible to move a species against these gradients, but now the flow must be driven by an exergonic process, such as the hydrolysis of ATP. This process is called active transport. The transport of ions into or out of a cell needs to be mediated (that is, facilitated by other species) because the hydrophobic environment of the membrane is inhospitable to ions. There are two mechanisms for ion transport: mediation by a carrier molecule and transport through a channel former, a protein that creates a hydrophilic pore through which the ion can pass. An example of a channel former is the polypeptide gramicidin A, which increases the membrane permeability to cations such as H+ , K+ , and Na+ . Ion channels are proteins that effect the movement of specific ions down a membrane potential gradient. They are highly selective, so there is a channel protein for Ca2+ , another for Cl− , and so on. The opening of the gate may be triggered by potential differences between the two sides of the membrane or by the binding of an effector molecule to a specific receptor site on the channel. Ions such as H+ , Na+ , K+ , and Ca2+ are often transported actively across membranes by integral proteins called ion pumps. Ion pumps are molecular machines that work by adopting conformations that are permeable to one ion but not others depending on the state of phosphorylation of the protein. Because protein phosphorylation requires dephosphorylation of ATP, the conformational change that opens or closes the pump is endergonic and requires the use of energy stored during metabolism. Synoptic table 21.7* Debye–Hückel–Onsager coefficients for (1,1)-electrolytes at 298 K Solvent A/(mS m2 mol−1 /(mol dm−3 )1/2 ) B/(mol dm−3 )−1/2 Methanol 15.61 0.923 Propanone 32.8 1.63 Water 6.02 0.229 * More values are given in the Data section. Fig. 21.20 The dependence of molar conductivities on the square root of the ionic strength, and comparison (straight lines) with the dependence predicted by the Debye–Hückel–Onsager theory. (°)/(Scmmol)mm- 21- LL 0 -40 -80 -120 I 1/2 0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 AgNO3 BaCl2 LaCl3 ZnSO4 LL I21.2 IMPACT ON BIOCHEMISTRY: ION CHANNELS AND ION PUMPS 771 Let’s consider some of the experimental approaches used in the study of ion channels. The structures of a number of channel proteins have been obtained by the now traditional X-ray diffraction techniques described in Chapter 20. Information about the flow of ions across channels and pumps is supplied by the patch clamp technique. One of many possible experimental arrangements is shown in Fig. 21.21. With mild suction, a ‘patch’ of membrane from a whole cell or a small section of a broken cell can be attached tightly to the tip of a micropipet filled with an electrolyte solution and containing an electronic conductor, the so-called patch electrode. A potential difference (the ‘clamp’) is applied between the patch electrode and an intracellular electronic conductor in contact with the cytosol of the cell. If the membrane is permeable to ions at the applied potential difference, a current flows through the completed circuit. Using narrow micropipette tips with diameters of less than 1 µm, ion currents of a few picoamperes (1 pA = 10−12 A) have been measured across sections of membranes containing only one ion channel protein. A detailed picture of the mechanism of action of ion channels has emerged from analysis of patch clamp data and structural data. Here we focus on the K+ ion channel protein, which, like all other mediators of ion transport, spans the membrane bilayer (Fig. 21.22). The pore through which ions move has a length of 3.4 nm and is divided into two regions: a wide region with a length of 2.2 nm and diameter of 1.0 nm and a narrow region with a length of 1.2 nm and diameter of 0.3 nm. The narrow region is called the selectivity filter of the K+ ion channel because it allows only K+ ions to pass. Filtering is a subtle process that depends on ionic size and the thermodynamic tendency of an ion to lose its hydrating water molecules. Upon entering the selectivity filter, the K+ ion is stripped of its hydrating shell and is then gripped by carbonyl groups of the protein. Dehydration of the K+ ion is endergonic (∆dehydG7 = +203 kJ mol−1 ), but is driven by the energy of interaction between the ion and the protein. The Na+ ion, though smaller than the K+ ion, does not pass through the selectivity filter of the K+ ion channel because interactions with the protein are not sufficient to compensate for the high Gibbs energy of dehydration of Na+ (∆dehydG7 = +301 kJ mol−1 ). More specifically, a dehydrated Na+ ion is too small and cannot be held tightly by the protein carbonyl groups, which are positioned for ideal interactions with the larger K+ ion. In its hydrated form, the Na+ ion is too large (larger than a dehydrated K+ ion), does not fit in the selectivity filter, and does not cross the membrane. Though very selective, a K+ ion channel can still let other ions pass through. For example, K+ and Tl+ ions have similar radii and Gibbs energies of dehydration, so Tl+ can cross the membrane. As a result, Tl+ is a neurotoxin because it replaces K+ in many neuronal functions. The efficiency of transfer of K+ ions through the channel can also be explained by structural features of the protein. For efficient transport to occur, a K+ ion must enter the protein, but then must not be allowed to remain inside for very long so that, as one K+ ion enters the channel from one side, another K+ ion leaves from the opposite side. An ion is lured into the channel by water molecules about halfway through the length of the membrane. Consequently, the thermodynamic cost of moving an ion from an aqueous environment to the less hydrophilic interior of the protein is minimized. The ion is ‘encouraged’ to leave the protein by electrostatic interactions in the selectivity filter, which can bind two K+ ions simultaneously, usually with a bridging water molecule. Electrostatic repulsion prevents the ions from binding too tightly, minimizing the residence time of an ion in the selectivity filter, and maximizing the transport rate. Now we turn our attention to a very important ion pump, the H+ -ATPase responsible for coupling of proton flow to synthesis of ATP from ADP and Pi (Impact I7.2). Structural studies show that the channel through which the protons flow is linked in Micropipette Power supply and current measuring device Intracellular electrode Patch electrode Cytosol Ion channel Cell Fig. 21.21 A representation of the patch clamp technique for the measurement of ionic currents through membranes in intact cells. A section of membrane containing an ion channel (shown as a green rectangle) is in tight contact with the tip of a micropipette containing an electrolyte solution and the patch electrode. An intracellular electronic conductor is inserted into the cytosol of the cell and the two conductors are connected to a power supply and current measuring device. 772 21 MOLECULES IN MOTION tandem to a unit composed of six protein molecules arranged in pairs of α and β subunits to form three interlocked αβ segments (Fig. 21.23). The conformations of the three pairs may be loose (L), tight (T), or open (O), and one of each type is present at each stage. A protein at the centre of the interlocked structure, the γ subunit shown as a white arrow, rotates and induces structural changes that cycle each of the three segments between L, T, and O conformations. At the start of a cycle, a T unit holds an ATP molecule. Then ADP and a Pi group migrate into the L site and, as it closes into T, the earlier T site opens into O and releases its ATP. The ADP and Pi in the T site meanwhile condense into ATP, and the new L site is ready for the cycle to begin again. The proton flux drives the rotation of the γ subunit, and hence the conformational changes of the α/β segments, as well as providing the energy for the condensation reaction itself. Several key aspects of this mechanism have been confirmed experimentally. For example, the rotation of the γ subunit has been observed directly by using single-molecule spectroscopy (Section 14.6). Diffusion We are now in a position to extend the discussion of ionic motion to cover the migration of neutral molecules and of ions in the absence of an applied electric field. We shall do this by expressing ion motion in a more general way than hitherto, and will thendiscoverthatthesameequationsapplyevenwhenthechargeontheparticlesiszero. 21.9 The thermodynamic view We saw in Part 1 that, at constant temperature and pressure, the maximum nonexpansion work that can be done per mole when a substance moves from a location where its chemical potential is µ to a location where its chemical potential is µ + dµ is dw = dµ. In a system in which the chemical potential depends on the position x, dw = dµ = p,T dx (21.54) We also saw in Chapter 2 (Table 2.1) that in general work can always be expressed in terms of an opposing force (which here we write F ), and that dw = −F dx (21.55) By comparing these two expressions, we see that the slope of the chemical potential can be interpreted as an effective force per mole of molecules. We write this thermodynamic force as F = − p,T [21.56] There is not necessarily a real force pushing the particles down the slope of the chemical potential. As we shall see, the force may represent the spontaneous tendency of the molecules to disperse as a consequence of the Second Law and the hunt for maximum entropy. (a) The thermodynamic force of a concentration gradient In a solution in which the activity of the solute is a, the chemical potential is µ = µ7 + RT ln a D F ∂µ ∂x A C D F ∂µ ∂x A C L L L T TT O O O ATP ATP ATPATP ATP ADP ADP Pi Pi L ADP Pi ATP L Fig. 21.23 The mechanism of action of H+ ATPase, a molecular motor that transports protons across the mitochondrial membrane and catalyses either the formation or hydrolysis of ATP. 2.2nm1.2nm 1.0 nm 0.3 nm Fig. 21.22 A schematic representation of the cross-section of a membrane-spanning K+ ion channel protein. The bulk of the protein is shown in beige. The pore through which ions move is divided into two regions: a wide region with a length of 2.2 nm and diameter of 1.0 nm, and a narrow region, the selectivity filter, with a length of 1.2 nm and diameter of 0.3 nm. The selectivity filter has a number of carbonyl groups (shown in dark green) that grip K+ ions. As explained in the text, electrostatic repulsions between two bound K+ ions ‘encourage’ ionic movement through the selectivity filter and across the membrane. 21.9 THE THERMODYNAMIC VIEW 773 If the solution is not uniform the activity depends on the position and we can write F = −RT p,T (21.57) If the solution is ideal, a may be replaced by the molar concentration c, and then F = − p,T (21.58)° where we have also used the relation d ln y/dx = (1/y)(dy/dx). Example 21.3 Calculating the thermodynamic force Suppose the concentration of a solute decays exponentially along the length of a container. Calculate the thermodynamic force on the solute at 25°C given that the concentration falls to half its value in 10 cm. Method According to eqn 21.58, the thermodynamic force is calculated by differentiating the concentration with respect to distance. Therefore, write an expression for the variation of the concentration with distance, and then differentiate it. Answer The concentration varies with position as c = c0e−x/λ where λ is the decay constant. Therefore, = − Equation 21.58 then implies that F = We know that the concentration falls to 1 –2c0 at x = 10 cm, so we can find λ from 1 –2 = e−(10 cm)/λ . That is, λ = (10 cm/ln 2). It follows that F = (8.3145 J K−1 mol−1 ) × (298 K) × ln 2/(1.0 × 10−1 m) = 17 kN mol−1 where we have used 1 J = 1 N m. Self-test 21.5 Calculate the thermodynamic force on the molecules of molar mass M in a vertical tube in a gravitational field on the surface of the Earth, and evaluate F for molecules of molar mass 100 g mol−1 . Comment on its magnitude relative to that just calculated. [F = −Mg, −0.98 N mol−1 ; the force arising from the concentration gradient greatly dominates that arising from the gravitational gradient.] (b) Fick’s first law of diffusion In Section 21.4 we saw that Fick’s first law of diffusion (that the particle flux is proportional to the concentration gradient) could be deduced from the kinetic model of gases. We shall now show that it can be deduced more generally and that it applies to the diffusion of species in condensed phases too. RT λ c λ dc dx D F ∂c ∂x A C RT c D F ∂ ln a ∂x A C 774 21 MOLECULES IN MOTION We suppose that the flux of diffusing particles is motion in response to a thermodynamic force arising from a concentration gradient. The particles reach a steady drift speed, s, when the thermodynamic force, F, is matched by the viscous drag. This drift speed is proportional to the thermodynamic force, and we write s ∝ F. However, the particle flux, J, is proportional to the drift speed, and the thermodynamic force is proportional to the concentration gradient, dc/dx. The chain of proportionalities (J ∝ s, s ∝ F, and F ∝ dc/dx) implies that J ∝ dc/dx, which is the content of Fick’s law. (c) The Einstein relation If we divide both sides of eqn 21.19 by Avogadro’s constant, thereby converting numbers into amounts (numbers of moles), then Fick’s law becomes J = −D (21.59) In this expression, D is the diffusion coefficient and dc/dx is the slope of the molar concentration. The flux is related to the drift speed by J = sc (21.60) This relation follows from the argument that we have used several times before. Thus, all particles within a distance s∆t, and therefore in a volume s∆tA, can pass through a window of area A in an interval ∆t. Hence, the amount of substance that can pass through the window in that interval is s∆tAc. Therefore, sc = −D If now we express dc/dx in terms of F by using eqn 21.58, we find s = − = (21.61) Therefore, once we know the effective force and the diffusion coefficient, D, we can calculate the drift speed of the particles (and vice versa) whatever the origin of the force. There is one case where we already know the drift speed and the effective force acting on a particle: an ion in solution has a drift speed s = uE when it experiences a force ezE from an electric field of strength E (so F = NAezE = zFE). Therefore, substituting these known values into eqn 21.61 gives uE = and hence u = (21.62) This equation rearranges into the very important result known as the Einstein relation between the diffusion coefficient and the ionic mobility: D = (21.63)° On inserting the typical value u = 5 × 10−8 m2 s−1 V−1 , we find D ≈ 1 × 10−9 m2 s−1 at 25°C as a typical value of the diffusion coefficient of an ion in water. uRT zF zFD RT zFED RT DF RT dc dx D c dc dx dc dx 21.9 THE THERMODYNAMIC VIEW 775 Synoptic table 21.8* Diffusion coefficients at 298 K D/(10−9 m2 s−1 ) H+ in water 9.31 I2 in hexane 4.05 Na+ in water 1.33 Sucrose in water 0.522 * More values are given in the Data section. (d) The Nernst–Einstein equation The Einstein relation provides a link between the molar conductivity of an electrolyte and the diffusion coefficients of its ions. First, by using eqns 21.44 and 21.63 we write λ = zuF = (21.64)° for each type of ion. Then, from Λ°m = ν+λ+ + ν−λ−, the limiting molar conductivity is Λm = (ν+z2 +D+ + ν−z2 −D−) (21.65)° which is the Nernst–Einstein equation. One application of this equation is to the determination of ionic diffusion coefficients from conductivity measurements; another is to the prediction of conductivities using models of ionic diffusion (see below). (e) The Stokes–Einstein equation Equations 21.43 (u = ez/f) and 21.63 relate the mobility of an ion to the frictional force and to the diffusion coefficient, respectively. We can combine the two expressions into the Stokes–Einstein equation: D = (21.66) If the frictional force is described by Stokes’s law, then we also obtain a relation between the diffusion coefficient and the viscosity of the medium: D = (21.67) An important feature of eqn 21.66 (and of its special case, eqn 21.67) is that it makes no reference to the charge of the diffusing species. Therefore, the equation also applies in the limit of vanishingly small charge, that is, it also applies to neutral molecules. Consequently, we may use viscosity measurements to estimate the diffusion coefficients for electrically neutral molecules in solution (Table 21.8). It must not be forgotten, however, that both equations depend on the assumption that the viscous drag is proportional to the speed. Example 21.4 Interpreting the mobility of an ion Use the experimental value of the mobility to evaluate the diffusion coefficient, the limiting molar conductivity, and the hydrodynamic radius of a sulfate ion in aqueous solution. Method The starting point is the mobility of the ion, which is given in Table 21.6. The diffusion coefficient can then be determined from the Einstein relation, eqn 21.63. The ionic conductivity is related to the mobility by eqn 21.44. To estimate the hydrodynamic radius, a, of the ion, use the Stokes–Einstein relation to find f and the Stokes law to relate f to a. Answer From Table 21.6, the mobility of SO4 2− is 8.29 × 10−8 m2 s−1 V−1 . It follows from eqn 21.63 that D = = 1.1 × 10−9 m2 s−1 uRT zF kT 6πηa kT f F2 RT z2 DF2 RT 776 21 MOLECULES IN MOTION x l+ x Area A J x A( ) J x l A( )+Volume Al Fig. 21.24 The net flux in a region is the difference between the flux entering from the region of high concentration (on the left) and the flux leaving to the region of low concentration (on the right). From eqn 21.44 it follows that λ = zuF = 16 mS m2 mol−1 Finally, from f = 6πηa using 0.891 cP (or 8.91 × 10−4 kg m−1 s−1 ) for the viscosity of water (Table 21.4): a = = 220 pm The bond length in SO4 2− is 144 pm, so the radius calculated here is plausible and consistent with a small degree of solvation. Self-test 21.6 Repeat the calculation for the NH4 + ion. [1.96 × 10−9 m2 s−1 , 7.4 mS m2 mol−1 , 125 pm] Experimental support for the relations derived above comes from conductivity measurements. In particular, Walden’s rule is the empirical observation that the product ηΛm is very approximately constant for the same ions in different solvents (but there are numerous exceptions). Because Λm ∝ D, and we have just seen that D ∝ 1/η, we do indeed predict that Λm ∝ 1/η, as Walden’s rule implies. The usefulness of the rule, however, is muddied by the role of solvation: different solvents solvate the same ions to different extents, so both the hydrodynamic radius and the viscosity change with the solvent. 21.10 The diffusion equation We now turn to the discussion of time-dependent diffusion processes, where we are interested in the spreading of inhomogeneities with time. One example is the temperature of a metal bar that has been heated at one end: if the source of heat is removed, then the bar gradually settles down into a state of uniform temperature. When the source of heat is maintained and the bar can radiate, it settles down into a steady state of nonuniform temperature. Another example (and one more relevant to chemistry) is the concentration distribution in a solvent to which a solute is added. We shall focus on the description of the diffusion of particles, but similar arguments apply to the diffusion of physical properties, such as temperature. Our aim is to obtain an equation for the rate of change of the concentration of particles in an inhomogeneous region. The central equation of this section is the diffusion equation, also called ‘Fick’s second law of diffusion’, which relates the rate of change of concentration at a point to the spatial variation of the concentration at that point: = D (21.68) We show in the following Justification that the diffusion equation follows from Fick’s first law of diffusion. Justification 21.6 The diffusion equation Consider a thin slab of cross-sectional area A that extends from x to x + l (Fig. 21.24). Let the concentration at x be c at the time t. The amount (number of moles) of particles that enter the slab in the infinitesimal interval dt is JAdt, so the rate of increase in molar concentration inside the slab (which has volume Al) on account of the flux from the left is ∂2 c ∂x2 ∂c ∂t kT 6πηD 21.10 THE DIFFUSION EQUATION 777 = = There is also an outflow through the right-hand window. The flux through that window is J′, and the rate of change of concentration that results is = − = − The net rate of change of concentration is therefore = Each flux is proportional to the concentration gradient at the window. So, by using Fick’s first law, we can write J − J′ = −D + D = −D + D c + l = Dl When this relation is substituted into the expression for the rate of change of concentration in the slab, we get eqn 21.68. The diffusion equation shows that the rate of change of concentration is proportional to the curvature (more precisely, to the second derivative) of the concentration with respect to distance. If the concentration changes sharply from point to point (if the distribution is highly wrinkled) then the concentration changes rapidly with time. Where the curvature is positive (a dip, Fig. 21.25), the change in concentration is positive; the dip tends to fill. Where the curvature is negative (a heap), the change in concentration is negative; the heap tends to spread. If the curvature is zero, then the concentration is constant in time. If the concentration decreases linearly with distance, then the concentration at any point is constant because the inflow of particles is exactly balanced by the outflow. The diffusion equation can be regarded as a mathematical formulation of the intuitive notion that there is a natural tendency for the wrinkles in a distribution to disappear. More succinctly: Nature abhors a wrinkle. (a) Diffusion with convection The transport of particles arising from the motion of a streaming fluid is called convection. If for the moment we ignore diffusion, then the flux of particles through an area A in an interval ∆t when the fluid is flowing at a velocity v can be calculated in the way we have used several times before (by counting the particles within a distance v∆t), and is J = = cv (21.69) This J is called the convective flux. The rate of change of concentration in a slab of thickness l and area A is, by the same argument as before and assuming that the velocity does not depend on the position, = = c − c + l = −v (21.70) When both diffusion and convection occur, the total change of concentration in a region is the sum of the two effects, and the generalized diffusion equation is ∂c ∂x v l 5 6 7 J K L D F ∂c ∂x A C G H I 1 2 3 J − J′ l ∂c ∂t cA∆vt A∆t ∂2 c ∂x2 5 6 7 D E F ∂c ∂x A B C 1 2 3 ∂ ∂x ∂c ∂x ∂c′ ∂x ∂c ∂x J − J′ l ∂c ∂t J′ l J′Adt Aldt ∂c ∂t J l JAdt Aldt ∂c ∂t Position, x Concentration,c Negative curvature Positive curvature Spreads Fills Fig. 21.25 Nature abhors a wrinkle. The diffusion equation tells us that peaks in distribution (regions of negative curvature) spread and troughs (regions of positive curvature) fill in. 778 21 MOLECULES IN MOTION = D − v (21.71) A further refinement, which is important in chemistry, is the possibility that the concentrations of particles may change as a result of reaction. When reactions are included in eqn 21.71 (Section 24.2), we get a powerful differential equation for discussing the properties of reacting, diffusing, convecting systems and which is the basis of reactor design in chemical industry and of the utilization of resources in living cells. (b) Solutions of the diffusion equation The diffusion equation, eqn 21.68, is a second-order differential equation with respect to space and a first-order differential equation with respect to time. Therefore, we must specify two boundary conditions for the spatial dependence and a single initial condition for the time-dependence. As an illustration, consider a solvent in which the solute is initially coated on one surface of the container (for example, a layer of sugar on the bottom of a deep beaker of water). The single initial condition is that at t = 0 all N0 particles are concentrated on the yz-plane (of area A) at x = 0. The two boundary conditions are derived from the requirements (1) that the concentration must everywhere be finite and (2) that the total amount (number of moles) of particles present is n0 (with n0 = N0/NA) at all times. These requirements imply that the flux of particles is zero at the top and bottom surfaces of the system. Under these conditions it is found that c(x,t) = e−x2 /4Dt (21.72) as may be verified by direct substitution. Figure 21.26 shows the shape of the concentration distribution at various times, and it is clear that the concentration spreads and tends to uniformity. Another useful result is for a localized concentration of solute in a threedimensional solvent (a sugar lump suspended in a large flask of water). The concentration of diffused solute is spherically symmetrical and at a radius r is c(r,t) = e−r2 /4Dt (21.73) Other chemically (and physically) interesting arrangements, such as transport of substances across biological membranes can be treated (Impact I21.3). In many cases the solutions are more cumbersome. (c) The measurement of diffusion coefficients The solutions of the diffusion equation are useful for experimental determinations of diffusion coefficients. In the capillary technique, a capillary tube, open at one end and containing a solution, is immersed in a well stirred larger quantity of solvent, and the change of concentration in the tube is monitored. The solute diffuses from the open end of the capillary at a rate that can be calculated by solving the diffusion equation with the appropriate boundary conditions, so D may be determined. In the diaphragm technique, the diffusion occurs through the capillary pores of a sintered glass diaphragm separating the well-stirred solution and solvent. The concentrations are monitored and then related to the solutions of the diffusion equation corresponding to this arrangement. Diffusion coefficients may also be measured by the dynamic light scattering technique described in Section 19.3 and by NMR. n0 8(πDt)3/2 n0 A(πDt)1/2 ∂c ∂x ∂2 c ∂x2 ∂c ∂t cnA/(/)0 0 0.5 1 1.5 2 2.5 0 0.5 1 1.5 2 x 1.0 0.3 0.1 0.05 Fig. 21.26 The concentration profiles above a plane from which a solute is diffusing. The curves are plots of eqn 21.72 and are labelled with different values of Dt. The units of Dt and x are arbitrary, but are related so that Dt/x2 is dimensionless. For example, if x is in metres, Dt would be in metres2 ; so, for D = 10−9 m2 s−1 , Dt = 0.1 m2 corresponds to t = 108 s. Exploration Generate a family of curves similar to that shown in Fig. 21.26 but by using eqn 21.73, which describes diffusion in three dimensions. I21.3 IMPACT ON BIOCHEMISTRY: TRANSPORT OF NON-ELECTROLYTES ACROSS BIOLOGICAL MEMBRANES 779 IMPACT ON BIOCHEMISTRY 21.3 Transport of non-electrolytes across biological membranes We saw in Impact I21.2 how electrolytes are transported across cell membranes. Here we use the diffusion equation to explore the way in which non-electrolytes cross the lipid bilayer. Consider the passive transport of an uncharged species A across a lipid bilayer of thickness l. To simplify the problem, we will assume that the concentration of A is always maintained at [A] = [A]0 on one surface of the membrane and at [A] = 0 on the other surface, perhaps by a perfect balance between the rate of the process that produces A on one side and the rate of another process that consumes A completely on the other side. This is one example of a steady-state assumption, which will be discussed in more detail in Section 22.7. Then ∂[A]/∂t = 0 and the diffusion equation simplifies to D = 0 (21.74) where D is the diffusion coefficient and the steady-state assumption makes partial derivatives unnecessary. We use the boundary conditions [A](0) = [A]0 and [A](l) = 0 to solve eqn 21.74 and the result, which may be verified by differentiation, is [A](x) = [A]0 1 − (21.75) which implies that the [A] decreases linearly inside the membrane. We now use Fick’s first law to calculate the flux J of A through the membrane and the result is J = D (21.76) However, we need to modify this equation slightly to account for the fact that the concentration of A on the surface of a membrane is not always equal to the concentration of A measured in the bulk solution, which we assume to be aqueous. This difference arises from the significant difference in the solubility of A in an aqueous environment and in the solution–membrane interface. One way to deal with this problem is to define a partition ratio, KD (D for distribution) as KD = [21.77] where [A]s is the concentration of A in the bulk aqueous solution. It follows that J = DKD (21.78) In spite of the assumptions that led to its final form, eqn 21.78 describes adequately the passive transport of many non-electrolytes through membranes of blood cells. In many cases the flux is underestimated by eqn 21.78 and the implication is that the membrane is more permeable than expected. However, the permeability increases only for certain species and not others and this is evidence that transport can be mediated by carriers. One example is the transporter protein that carries glucose into cells. A characteristic of a carrier C is that it binds to the transported species A and the dissociation of the AC complex is described by AC 5 A + C K = (21.79) [A][C] [AC] [A]s l [A]0 [A]s [A]0 l D F x l A C d2 [A] dx2 780 21 MOLECULES IN MOTION 0 2 4 6 8 10 0 0.5 1 Concentration, [A]/K Flux,/JJmax Fig. 21.27 The flux of the species AC through a membrane varies with the concentration of the species A. The behaviour shown in the figure and explained in the text is characteristic of mediated transport of A, with C as a carrier molecule. where we have used concentrations instead of activities. After writing [C]0 = [C] + [AC], where [C]0 is the total concentration of carrier, it follows that [AC] = (21.80) We can now use eqns 21.80 and 21.78 to write an expression for the flux of the species AC through the membrane: J = = Jmax (21.81) where KD and D are the partition ratio and diffusion coefficient of the species AC. We see from Fig. 21.27 that when [A] << K the flux varies linearly with [A] and that the flux reaches a maximum value of Jmax = DKD[C]0/l when [A] >> K. This behaviour is characteristic of mediated transport. 21.11 Diffusion probabilities The solutions of the diffusion equation can be used to predict the concentration of particles (or the value of some other physical quantity, such as the temperature in a nonuniform system) at any location. We can also use them to calculate the net distance through which the particles diffuse in a given time. Example 21.5 Calculating the net distance of diffusion Calculate the net distance travelled on average by particles in a time t if they have a diffusion constant D. Method We need to use the results of probability theory summarized in Appendix 2. In this case, we calculate the probability that a particle will be found at a certain distance from the origin, and then calculate the average by weighting each distance by that probability. Answer The number of particles in a slab of thickness dx and area A at x, where the molar concentration is c, is cANAdx. The probability that any of the N0 = n0NA particles is in the slab is therefore cANAdx/N0. If the particle is in the slab, it has travelled a distance x from the origin. Therefore, the mean distance travelled by all the particles is the sum of each x weighted by the probability of its occurrence: ͗x͘ = Ύ ∞ 0 dx = Ύ ∞ 0 xe−x2 /4Dt dx = 2 1/2 where we have used the same standard integral as that used in Justification 21.4. The average distance of diffusion varies as the square root of the lapsed time. If we use the Stokes–Einstein relation for the diffusion coefficient, the mean distance travelled by particles of radius a in a solvent of viscosity η is ͗x͘ = 1/2 Self-test 21.7 Derive an expression for the root mean square distance travelled by diffusing particles in a time t. [͗x2 ͘1/2 = (2Dt)1/2 ] D F 2kTt 3π2 ηa A C D F Dt π A C 1 (πDt)1/2 xcANA N0 [A] [A] + K [A] [A] + K DKD[C]0 l [A][C]0 [A] + K 21.12 THE STATISTICAL VIEW 781 As shown in Example 21.5, the average distance travelled by diffusing particle in a time t is ͗x͘ = 2 1/2 (21.82) and the root mean square distance travelled in the same time is ͗x2 ͘1/2 = (2Dt)1/2 (21.83) The latter is a valuable measure of the spread of particles when they can diffuse in both directions from the origin (for then ͗x͘ = 0 at all times). The root mean square distance travelled by particles with a typical diffusion coefficient (D = 5 × 10−10 m2 s−1 ) is illustrated in Fig. 21.28, which shows how long it takes for diffusion to increase the net distance travelled on average to about 1 cm in an unstirred solution. The graph shows that diffusion is a very slow process (which is why solutions are stirred, to encourage mixing by convection). 21.12 The statistical view An intuitive picture of diffusion is of the particles moving in a series of small steps and gradually migrating from their original positions. We shall explore this idea using a model in which the particles can jump through a distance λ in a time τ. The total distance travelled by a particle in a time t is therefore tλ/τ. However, the particle will not necessarily be found at that distance from the origin. The direction of each step may be different, and the net distance travelled must take the changing directions into account. If we simplify the discussion by allowing the particles to travel only along a straight line (the x-axis), and for each step (to the left or the right) to be through the same distance λ, then we obtain the one-dimensional random walk. The same model was used in the discussion of a one-dimensional random coil in Section 19.8a. We show in the Justification below that the probability of a particle being at a distance x from the origin after a time t is P = 1/2 e−x2 τ/2tλ2 (21.84) Justification 21.7 The one-dimensional random walk Consider a one-dimensional random walk in which each step is through a distance λ to the left or right. The net distance travelled after N steps is equal to the difference between the number of steps to the right (NR) and to the left (NL), and is (NR −NL)λ. We write n = NR −NL and the total number of steps as N = NR + NL. The number of ways of performing a walk with a given net distance of travel nλ is the number of ways of making NR steps to the right and NL steps to the left, and is given by the binomial coefficient W = = The probability of the net distance walked being nλ is P = = = N! {1–2(N + n)}!{1–2(N − n)}!2N W 2N number of paths with NR steps to the right total number of steps N! {1–2(N + n)}!{1–2(N − n)}! N! NL!NR! D F 2τ πt A C D F Dt π A C 0 -2 -4 -6 -8 -10 log(/m)x21/2 -10 -6 -2 0 2 6 log ( /s)t 1 m 1 cm 1 mm 1 mm 1 nm 1 sm 1 ms1 s 1 d1 y1 h Fig. 21.28 The root mean square distance covered by particles with D = 5 × 10−10 m2 s−1 . Note the great slowness of diffusion. 782 21 MOLECULES IN MOTION The use of Stirling’s approximation (Section 16.1a) in the form ln x! ≈ ln(2π)1/2 + (x + 1–2) ln x − x gives (after quite a lot of algebra; see Problem 21.33) ln P = ln 1/2 − 1–2(N + n + 1)ln 1 + − 1–2(N − n + 1)ln 1 − For small net distances (n << N) we can use the approximation ln(1 ± x) ≈ ±x − 1–2x2 , and so obtain ln P ≈ ln 1/2 − At this point, we note that the number of steps taken in a time t is N = t/τ and the net distance travelled from the origin is x = nλ. Substitution of these quantities into the expression for ln P gives ln P ≈ ln 1/2 − which, upon using eln x = x and ex+y = ex ey , rearranges into eqn 21.84. The differences of detail between eqns 21.72 and 21.84 arise from the fact that in the present calculation the particles can migrate in either direction from the origin. Moreover, they can be found only at discrete points separated by λ instead of being anywhere on a continuous line. The fact that the two expressions are so similar suggests that diffusion can indeed be interpreted as the outcome of a large number of steps in random directions. We can now relate the coefficient D to the step length λ and the rate at which the jumps occur. Thus, by comparing the two exponents in eqns 21.72 and 21.84 we can immediately write down the Einstein–Smoluchowski equation: D = (21.85) Illustration 21.6 Using the Einstein–Smoluchowski equation Suppose that a SO4 2− ion jumps through its own diameter each time it makes a move in an aqueous solution; then, because D = 1.1 × 10−9 m2 s−1 and a = 210 pm (as deduced from mobility measurements), it follows from λ = 2a that τ = 80 ps. Because τ is the time for one jump, the ion makes 1 × 1010 jumps per second. The Einstein–Smoluchowski equation is the central connection between the microscopic details of particle motion and the macroscopic parameters relating to diffusion (for example, the diffusion coefficient and, through the Stokes–Einstein relation, the viscosity). It also brings us back full circle to the properties of the perfect gas. For if we interpret λ/τ as K, the mean speed of the molecules, and interpret λ as a mean free path, then we can recognize in the Einstein–Smoluchowski equation exactly the same expression as we obtained from the kinetic model of gases, eqn 21.22. That is, the diffusion of a perfect gas is a random walk with an average step size equal to the mean free path. λ2 2τ x2 τ 2tλ2 D E F 2τ πt A B C n2 2N D E F 2 πN A B C D E F n N A B C D E F n N A B C D E F 2 πN A B C FURTHER READING 783 Checklist of key ideas 1. Diffusion is the migration of matter down a concentration gradient; thermal conduction is the migration of energy down a temperature gradient; electric conduction is the migration of electric charge along an electrical potential gradient; viscosity is the migration of linear momentum down a velocity gradient. 2. The kinetic model of a gas considers only the contribution to the energy from the kinetic energies of the molecules. Important results from the model include expressions for the pressure (pV = 1 –3nMc2 ) and the root mean square speed (c = ͗v2 ͘1/2 = (3RT/M)1/2 ). 3. The Maxwell distribution of speeds is the function which, through f(v)dv, gives the fraction of molecules that have speeds in the range v to v + dv. 4. The collision frequency is the number of collisions made by a molecule in an interval divided by the length of the interval: z = σKrelN , where the collision cross-section is σ = πd2 . 5. The mean free path is the average distance a molecule travels between collisions: λ = K/z. 6. The collision flux, ZW, is the number of collisions with an area in a given time interval divided by the area and the duration of the interval: Zw = p/(2πmkT)1/2 . 7. Effusion is the emergence of a gas from a container through a small hole. Graham’s law of effusion states that the rate of effusion is inversely proportional to the square root of the molar mass. 8. Flux J is the quantity of a property passing through a given area in a given time interval divided by the area and the duration of the interval. 9. Fick’s first law of diffusion states that the flux of matter is proportional to the concentration gradient, J(matter) = −DdN /dz, where D is the diffusion coefficient. 10. The conductance, G, is the inverse of resistance. The conductivity is the constant κ in G = κA/l and the molar conductivity is written as Λm = κ/c. 11. A strong electrolyte is an electrolyte with a molar conductivity that varies only slightly with concentration. A weak electrolyte is an electrolyte with a molar conductivity that is normal at concentrations close to zero, but falls sharply to low values as the concentration increases. 12. Kohlrausch’s law for the concentration dependence of the molar conductivity of a strong electrolyte is written as Λm = Λ°m − K c1/2 , where the limiting molar conductivity, Λ°m, is the molar conductivity at zero concentration (Λ°m = ν+λ+ + ν−λ−). 13. The drift speed s is the terminal speed when an accelerating force is balanced by the viscous drag: s = uE, where u = ze/6πηa is the ionic mobility and a is the hydrodynamic radius (Stokes radius), the effective radius of a particle in solution. 14. The ionic conductivity is the contribution of ions of one type to the molar conductivity: λ = zuF. 15. The transport number is the fraction of total current I carried by the ions of a specified type: t± = I±/I. 16. The Debye–Hückel–Onsager theory explains the concentration dependence of the molar conductivity of a strong electrolyte in terms of ionic interactions. 17. The Einstein relation between the diffusion coefficient and the ionic mobility is D = uRT/zF. 18. The Nernst–Einstein relation between the molar conductivity of an electrolyte and the diffusion coefficients of its ions is Λm = (ν+z2 +D+ + ν−z2 −D−)(F2 /RT). 19. The Stokes–Einstein equation relates the diffusion coefficient to the frictional force: D = kT/f. 20. Walden’s rule states that the product ηΛm is very approximately constant for the same ions in different solvents. 21. The diffusion equation is a relation between the rate of change of concentration at a point and the spatial variation of the concentration at that point: ∂c/∂t = D∂2 c/∂x2 . 22. In a one-dimensional random walk, the probability P that a molecule moves a distance x from the origin for a period t by taking small steps with size λ and time τ is: P = (2τ/πt)1/2 e−x2τ/2tλ2 . 23. The Einstein–Smoluchowski equation relates the diffusion coefficient to the parameters used in the formulation of the random walk model, D = λ2 /2τ. Further reading Articles and texts D.G. Leaist, Diffusion and ionic conduction in liquids. In Encyclopedia of applied physics (ed. G.L. Trigg), 5, 661 VCH, New York (1993). A.J. Bard and L.R. Faulkner, Electrochemical methods: fundamentals and applications. Wiley, New York (2000). R.B. Bird, W.E. Stewart, and E.N. Lightfoot, Transport phenomena. Wiley, New-York (1960). J.N. Murrell and A.D. Jenkins, Properties of liquids and solutions. Wiley-Interscience, New York (1994). K.E. van Holde, W.C. Johnson, and P.S. Ho, Principles of physical biochemistry. Prentice Hall, Upper Saddle River (1998). A.J. Walton, Three phases of matter. Oxford University Press (1983). 784 21 MOLECULES IN MOTION Sources of data and information D.R. Lide (ed.), CRC Handbook of Chemistry and Physics, Sections 5 and 6. CRC Press, Boca Raton (2000). NIST thermodynamic and transport properties of pure fluids database, NIST standard reference database 12, National Institute of Standards and Testing, Gaithersburg (1995). This material is on CD-ROM. N ( )N (0) N ( )+ N - - 0 0 l l z z Area A l l l l Fig. 21.29 The calculation of the rate of diffusion of a gas considers the net flux of molecules through a plane of area A as a result of arrivals from on average a distance λ away in each direction, where λ is the mean free path. Short flight (survives) Long flight (collides in flight) Fig. 21.30 One approximation ignored in the simple treatment is that some particles might make a long flight to the plane even though they are only a short perpendicular distance away, and therefore they have a higher chance of colliding during their journey. Further information Further information 21.1 The transport characteristics of a perfect gas In this Further information section, we derive expressions for the diffusion characteristics (specifically, the diffusion coefficient, the thermal conductivity, and the viscosity) of a perfect gas on the basis of the kinetic molecular theory. The diffusion coefficient, D Consider the arrangement depicted in Fig. 21.29. On average, the molecules passing through the area A at z = 0 have travelled about one mean free path λ since their last collision. Therefore, the number density where they originated is N (z) evaluated at z = −λ. This number density is approximately N(−λ) = N(0) − λ 0 (21.86) where we have used a Taylor expansion of the form f(x) = f(0) + (df/dx)0x + · · · truncated after the second term (see Appendix 2). The average number of impacts on the imaginary window of area A0 during an interval ∆t is ZWA0∆t, with ZW = 1 –4N K (eqn 21.15). Therefore, the flux from left to right, J(L→R), arising from the supply of molecules on the left, is J(L → R) = = 1–4N(−λ)K (21.87) 1–4A0N(−λ)K∆t A0∆t D E F dN dz A B C There is also a flux of molecules from right to left. On average, the molecules making the journey have originated from z = +λ where the number density is N(λ). Therefore, J(L ← R) = −1–4N(λ)K (21.88) The average number density at z = +λ is approximately N (λ) = N (0) + λ 0 (21.89) The net flux is Jz = J(L → R) + J(L ← R) = 1–4K N(0) − λ 0 − N(0) + λ 0 (21.90) = −1–2Kλ 0 This equation shows that the flux is proportional to the first derivative of the concentration, in agreement with Fick’s law. At this stage it looks as though we can pick out a value of the diffusion coefficient by comparing eqns 21.19 and 21.90, so obtaining D = 1–2λK. It must be remembered, however, that the calculation is quite crude, and is little more than an assessment of the order of magnitude of D. One aspect that has not been taken into account is illustrated in Fig. 21.30, which shows that, although a molecule may D E F dN dz A B C 5 6 7 J K L D E F dN dz A B C G H I J K L D E F dN dz A B C G H I 1 2 3 D E F dN dz A B C DISCUSSION QUESTIONS 785 have begun its journey very close to the window, it could have a long flight before it gets there. Because the path is long, the molecule is likely to collide before reaching the window, so it ought to be added to the graveyard of other molecules that have collided. To take this effect into account involves a lot of work, but the end result is the appearance of a factor of 2–3 representing the lower flux. The modification results in eqn 21.22. Thermal conductivity According to the equipartition theorem (Section 17.3), each molecule carries an average energy ε = νkT, where ν is a number of the order of 1. For monatomic particles, ν = 3–2. When one molecule passes through the imaginary window, it transports that energy on average. We suppose that the number density is uniform but that the temperature is not. On average, molecules arrive from the left after travelling a mean free path from their last collision in a hotter region, and therefore with a higher energy. Molecules also arrive from the right after travelling a mean free path from a cooler region. The two opposing energy fluxes are therefore J(L → R) = 1–4KN ε(−λ) ε(−λ) = νk T − λ 0 J(L ← R) = −1–4KNε(λ) ε(λ) = νk T + λ 0 (21.91) and the net flux is Jz = J(L → R) + J(L ← R) = −1–2νkλKN 0 (21.92) As before, we multiply by 2–3 to take long flight paths into account, and so arrive at Jz = −1–3νkλKN 0 (21.93) The energy flux is proportional to the temperature gradient, as we wanted to show. Comparison of this equation with eqn 21.20 shows that κ = 1–3νkλKN (21.94) Equation 21.23 then follows from CV,m = νkNA for a perfect gas, where [A] is the molar concentration of A. For this step, we use N = N/V = nNA/V = NA[A]. Viscosity Molecules travelling from the right in Fig. 21.31 (from a fast layer to a slower one) transport a momentum mvx(λ) to their new layer at z = 0; D E F dT dz A B C D E F dT dz A B C 5 6 7 D E F dT dz A B C 1 2 3 5 6 7 D E F dT dz A B C 1 2 3 those travelling from the left transport mvx(−λ) to it. If it is assumed that the density is uniform, the collision flux is 1 –4N K. Those arriving from the right on average carry a momentum mvx(λ) = mvx(0) + mλ 0 (21.95a) Those arriving from the left bring a momentum mvx(−λ) = mvx(0) − mλ 0 (21.95b) The net flux of x-momentum in the z-direction is therefore J = 1–4NK mvx(0) − mλ 0 − mvx(0) + mλ 0 = −1–2NmλK 0 (21.96) The flux is proportional to the velocity gradient, as we wished to show. Comparison of this expression with eqn 21.21, and multiplication by 2–3 in the normal way, leads to η = 1–3NmλK (21.97) which can easily be converted into eqn 21.24 by using Nm = nM and [A] = n/V. D E F dvx dz A B C 5 6 7 J K L D E F dvx dz A B C G H I J K L D E F dvx dz A B C G H I 1 2 3 D E F dvx dz A B C D E F dvx dz A B C Slow layer Fast layer 0 l - z x l Fig. 21.31 The calculation of the viscosity of a gas examines the net xcomponent of momentum brought to a plane from faster and slower layers on average a mean free path away in each direction. Discussion questions 21.1 Use the kinetic theory to justify the following observations: (a) the rate of a reaction in the gas phase depends on the energy with which two molecules collide, which in turn depends on their speeds; (b) in the Earth’s atmosphere, light gases, such as H2 and He, are rare but heavier gases, such as O2, CO2, and N2, are abundant. 21.2 Provide a molecular interpretation for each of the following processes: diffusion, thermal conduction, electric conduction, and viscosity. 21.3 Provide a molecular interpretation for the observation that the viscosity of a gas increases with temperature, whereas the viscosity of a liquid decreases with increasing temperature. 786 21 MOLECULES IN MOTION 21.4 Discuss the mechanism of proton conduction in liquid water. 21.5 Limit the generality of the following expressions: (a) J = −D(dc/dx), (b) D = kT/f, and (c) D = kT/6πηa. 21.6 Provide a molecular interpretation for the observation that mediated transport across a biological membrane leads to a maximum flux Jmax when the concentration of the transported species becomes very large. 21.7 Discuss how nuclear magnetic resonance spectroscopy, inelastic neutron scattering, and dynamic light scattering may be used to measure the mobility of molecules in liquids. Exercises 21.1a Determine the ratios of (a) the mean speeds, (b) the mean kinetic energies of H2 molecules and Hg atoms at 20°C. 21.1b Determine the ratios of (a) the mean speeds, (b) the mean kinetic energies of He atoms and Hg atoms at 25°C. 21.2a A 1.0 dm3 glass bulb contains 1.0 × 1023 H2 molecules. If the pressure exerted by the gas is 100 kPa, what are (a) the temperature of the gas, (b) the root mean square speeds of the molecules? (c) Would the temperature be different if they were O2 molecules? 21.2b The best laboratory vacuum pump can generate a vacuum of about 1 nTorr. At 25°C and assuming that air consists of N2 molecules with a collision diameter of 395 pm, calculate (a) the mean speed of the molecules, (b) the mean free path, (c) the collision frequency in the gas. 21.3a At what pressure does the mean free path of argon at 25°C become comparable to the size of a 1 dm3 vessel that contains it? Take σ = 0.36 nm2 . 21.3b At what pressure does the mean free path of argon at 25°C become comparable to the diameters of the atoms themselves? 21.4a At an altitude of 20 km the temperature is 217 K and the pressure 0.050 atm. What is the mean free path of N2 molecules? (σ = 0.43 nm2 .) 21.4b At an altitude of 15 km the temperature is 217 K and the pressure 12.1 kPa. What is the mean free path of N2 molecules? (σ = 0.43 nm2 .) 21.5a How many collisions does a single Ar atom make in 1.0 s when the temperature is 25°C and the pressure is (a) 10 atm, (b) 1.0 atm, (c) 1.0 µatm? 21.5b How many collisions per second does an N2 molecule make at an altitude of 15 km? (See Exercise 21.4b for data.) 21.6a Calculate the mean free path of molecules in air using σ = 0.43 nm2 at 25°C and (a) 10 atm, (b) 1.0 atm, (c) 1.0 µatm. 21.6b Calculate the mean free path of carbon dioxide molecules using σ = 0.52 nm2 at 25°C and (a) 15 atm, (b) 1.0 bar, (c) 1.0 Torr. 21.7a Use the Maxwell distribution of speeds to estimate the fraction of N2 molecules at 500 K that have speeds in the range 290 to 300 m s−1 . 21.7b Use the Maxwell distribution of speeds to estimate the fraction of CO2 molecules at 300 K that have speeds in the range 200 to 250 m s−1 . 21.8a A solid surface with dimensions 2.5 mm × 3.0 mm is exposed to argon gas at 90 Pa and 500 K. How many collisions do the Ar atoms make with this surface in 15 s? 21.8b A solid surface with dimensions 3.5 mm × 4.0 cm is exposed to helium gas at 111 Pa and 1500 K. How many collisions do the He atoms make with this surface in 10 s? 21.9a An effusion cell has a circular hole of diameter 2.50 mm. If the molar mass of the solid in the cell is 260 g mol−1 and its vapour pressure is 0.835 Pa at 400 K, by how much will the mass of the solid decrease in a period of 2.00 h? 21.9b An effusion cell has a circular hole of diameter 3.00 mm. If the molar mass of the solid in the cell is 300 g mol−1 and its vapour pressure is 0.224 Pa at 450 K, by how much will the mass of the solid decrease in a period of 24.00 h? 21.10a A manometer was connected to a bulb containing carbon dioxide under slight pressure. The gas was allowed to escape through a small pinhole, and the time for the manometer reading to drop from 75 cm to 50 cm was 52 s. When the experiment was repeated using nitrogen (for which M = 28.02 g mol−1 ) the same fall took place in 42 s. Calculate the molar mass of carbon dioxide. 21.10b A manometer was connected to a bulb containing nitrogen under slight pressure. The gas was allowed to escape through a small pinhole, and the time for the manometer reading to drop from 65.1 cm to 42.1 cm was 18.5 s. When the experiment was repeated using a fluorocarbon gas, the same fall took place in 82.3 s. Calculate the molar mass of the fluorocarbon. 21.11a A space vehicle of internal volume 3.0 m3 is struck by a meteor and a hole of radius 0.10 mm is formed. If the oxygen pressure within the vehicle is initially 80 kPa and its temperature 298 K, how long will the pressure take to fall to 70 kPa? 21.11b A container of internal volume 22.0 m3 was punctured, and a hole of radius 0.050 mm was formed. If the nitrogen pressure within the vehicle is initially 122 kPa and its temperature 293 K, how long will the pressure take to fall to 105 kPa? 21.12a Calculate the flux of energy arising from a temperature gradient of 2.5 K m−1 in a sample of argon in which the mean temperature is 273 K. 21.12b Calculate the flux of energy arising from a temperature gradient of 3.5 K m−1 in a sample of hydrogen in which the mean temperature is 260 K. 21.13a Use the experimental value of the thermal conductivity of neon (Table 21.2) to estimate the collision cross-section of Ne atoms at 273 K. 21.13b Use the experimental value of the thermal conductivity of nitrogen (Table 21.2) to estimate the collision cross-section of N2 molecules at 298 K. 21.14a In a double-glazed window, the panes of glass are separated by 5.0 cm. What is the rate of transfer of heat by conduction from the warm room (25°C) to the cold exterior (−10°C) through a window of area 1.0 m2 ? What power of heater is required to make good the loss of heat? 21.14b Two sheets of copper of area 1.50 m2 are separated by 10.0 cm. What is the rate of transfer of heat by conduction from the warm sheet (50°C) to the cold sheet (−10°C). What is the rate of loss of heat? 21.15a Use the experimental value of the coefficient of viscosity for neon (Table 21.2) to estimate the collision cross-section of Ne atoms at 273 K. 21.15b Use the experimental value of the coefficient of viscosity for nitrogen (Table 21.2) to estimate the collision cross-section of the molecules at 273 K. 21.16a Calculate the inlet pressure required to maintain a flow rate of 9.5 × 105 dm3 h−1 of nitrogen at 293 K flowing through a pipe of length 8.50 m EXERCISES 787 and diameter 1.00 cm. The pressure of gas as it leaves the tube is 1.00 bar. The volume of the gas is measured at that pressure. 21.16b Calculate the inlet pressure required to maintain a flow rate of 8.70 cm3 s−1 of nitrogen at 300 K flowing through a pipe of length 10.5 m and diameter 15 mm. The pressure of gas as it leaves the tube is 1.00 bar. The volume of the gas is measured at that pressure. 21.17a Calculate the viscosity of air at (a) 273 K, (b) 298 K, (c) 1000 K. Take σ ≈ 0.40 nm2 . (The experimental values are 173 µP at 273 K, 182 µP at 20°C, and 394 µP at 600°C.) 21.17b Calculate the viscosity of benzene vapour at (a) 273 K, (b) 298 K, (c) 1000 K. Take σ ≈ 0.88 nm2 . 21.18a Calculate the thermal conductivities of (a) argon, (b) helium at 300 K and 1.0 mbar. Each gas is confined in a cubic vessel of side 10 cm, one wall being at 310 K and the one opposite at 295 K. What is the rate of flow of energy as heat from one wall to the other in each case? 21.18b Calculate the thermal conductivities of (a) neon, (b) nitrogen at 300 K and 15 mbar. Each gas is confined in a cubic vessel of side 15 cm, one wall being at 305 K and the one opposite at 295 K. What is the rate of flow of energy as heat from one wall to the other in each case? 21.19a The viscosity of carbon dioxide was measured by comparing its rate of flow through a long narrow tube (using Poiseuille’s formula) with that of argon. For the same pressure differential, the same volume of carbon dioxide passed through the tube in 55 s as argon in 83 s. The viscosity of argon at 25°C is 208 µP; what is the viscosity of carbon dioxide? Estimate the molecular diameter of carbon dioxide. 21.19b The viscosity of a chlorofluorocarbon (CFC) was measured by comparing its rate of flow through a long narrow tube (using Poiseuille’s formula) with that of argon. For the same pressure differential, the same volume of the CFC passed through the tube in 72.0 s as argon in 18.0 s. The viscosity of argon at 25°C is 208 µP; what is the viscosity of the CFC? Estimate the molecular diameter of the CFC. Take M = 200 g mol−1 . 21.20a Calculate the thermal conductivity of argon (CV,m = 12.5 J K−1 mol−1 , σ = 0.36 nm2 ) at room temperature (20°C). 21.20b Calculate the thermal conductivity of nitrogen (CV,m = 20.8 J K−1 mol−1 , σ = 0.43 nm2 ) at room temperature (20°C). 21.21a Calculate the diffusion constant of argon at 25°C and (a) 1.00 Pa, (b) 100 kPa, (c) 10.0 MPa. If a pressure gradient of 0.10 atm cm−1 is established in a pipe, what is the flow of gas due to diffusion? 21.21b Calculate the diffusion constant of nitrogen at 25°C and (a) 10.0 Pa, (b) 100 kPa, (c) 15.0 MPa. If a pressure gradient of 0.20 bar m−1 is established in a pipe, what is the flow of gas due to diffusion? 21.22a The mobility of a chloride ion in aqueous solution at 25°C is 7.91 × 10−8 m2 s−1 V−1 . Calculate the molar ionic conductivity. 21.22b The mobility of an acetate ion in aqueous solution at 25°C is 4.24 × 10−8 m2 s−1 V−1 . Calculate the molar ionic conductivity. 21.23a The mobility of a Rb+ ion in aqueous solution is 7.92 × 10−8 m2 s−1 V−1 at 25°C. The potential difference between two electrodes placed in the solution is 35.0 V. If the electrodes are 8.00 mm apart, what is the drift speed of the Rb+ ion? 21.23b The mobility of a Li+ ion in aqueous solution is 4.01 × 10−8 m2 s−1 V−1 at 25°C. The potential difference between two electrodes placed in the solution is 12.0 V. If the electrodes are 1.00 cm apart, what is the drift speed of the ion? 21.24a What fraction of the total current is carried by Li+ when current flows through an aqueous solution of LiBr at 25°C? 21.24b What fraction of the total current is carried by Cl− when current flows through an aqueous solution of NaCl at 25°C? 21.25a The limiting molar conductivities of KCl, KNO3, and AgNO3 are 14.99 mS m2 mol−1 , 14.50 mS m2 mol−1 , and 13.34 mS m2 mol−1 , respectively (all at 25°C). What is the limiting molar conductivity of AgCl at this temperature? 21.25b The limiting molar conductivities of NaI, NaCH3CO2, and Mg(CH3CO2)2 are 12.69 mS m2 mol−1 , 9.10 mS m2 mol−1 , and 18.78 mS m2 mol−1 , respectively (all at 25°C). What is the limiting molar conductivity of MgI2 at this temperature? 21.26a At 25°C the molar ionic conductivities of Li+ , Na+ , and K+ are 3.87 mS m2 mol−1 , 5.01 mS m2 mol−1 , and 7.35 mS m2 mol−1 , respectively. What are their mobilities? 21.26b At 25°C the molar ionic conductivities of F− , Cl− , and Br− are 5.54 mS m2 mol−1 , 7.635 mS m2 mol−1 , and 7.81 mS m2 mol−1 , respectively. What are their mobilities? 21.27a The mobility of a NO3 − ion in aqueous solution at 25°C is 7.40 × 10−8 m2 s−1 V−1 . Calculate its diffusion coefficient in water at 25°C. 21.27b The mobility of a CH3CO2 − ion in aqueous solution at 25°C is 4.24 × 10−8 m2 s−1 V−1 . Calculate its diffusion coefficient in water at 25°C. 21.28a The diffusion coefficient of CCl4 in heptane at 25°C is 3.17 × 10−9 m2 s−1 . Estimate the time required for a CCl4 molecule to have a root mean square displacement of 5.0 mm. 21.28b The diffusion coefficient of I2 in hexane at 25°C is 4.05 × 10−9 m2 s−1 . Estimate the time required for an iodine molecule to have a root mean square displacement of 1.0 cm. 21.29a Estimate the effective radius of a sucrose molecule in water 25°C given that its diffusion coefficient is 5.2 × 10−10 m2 s−1 and that the viscosity of water is 1.00 cP. 21.29b Estimate the effective radius of a glycine molecule in water at 25°C given that its diffusion coefficient is 1.055 × 10−9 m2 s−1 and that the viscosity of water is 1.00 cP. 21.30a The diffusion coefficient for molecular iodine in benzene is 2.13 × 10−9 m2 s−1 . How long does a molecule take to jump through about one molecular diameter (approximately the fundamental jump length for translational motion)? 21.30b The diffusion coefficient for CCl4 in heptane is 3.17 × 10−9 m2 s−1 . How long does a molecule take to jump through about one molecular diameter (approximately the fundamental jump length for translational motion)? 21.31a What are the root mean square distances travelled by an iodine molecule in benzene and by a sucrose molecule in water at 25°C in 1.0 s? 21.31b About how long, on average, does it take for the molecules in Exercise 21.31a to drift to a point (a) 1.0 mm, (b) 1.0 cm from their starting points? 788 21 MOLECULES IN MOTION Problems* Numerical problems 21.1 Instead of the arrangement in Fig. 21.8, the speed of molecules can also be measured with a rotating slotted-disc apparatus, which consists of five coaxial 5.0 cm diameter discs separated by 1.0 cm, the slots in their rims being displaced by 2.0° between neighbours. The relative intensities, I, of the detected beam of Kr atoms for two different temperatures and at a series of rotation rates were as follows: ν/Hz 20 40 80 100 120 I (40 K) 0.846 0.513 0.069 0.015 0.002 I (100 K) 0.592 0.485 0.217 0.119 0.057 Find the distributions of molecular velocities, f(vx), at these temperatures, and check that they conform to the theoretical prediction for a one-dimensional system. 21.2 Cars were timed by police radar as they passed in both directions below a bridge. Their velocities (kilometres per hour, numbers of cars in parentheses) to the east and west were as follows: 80 E (40), 85 E (62), 90 E (53), 95 E (12), 100 E (2); 80 W (38), 85 W (59), 90 W (50), 95 W (10), 100 W (2). What are (a) the mean velocity, (b) the mean speed, (c) the root mean square speed? 21.3 A population consists of people of the following heights (in metres, numbers of individuals in brackets): 1.80 (1), 1.82 (2), 1.84 (4), 1.86 (7), 1.88 (10), 1.90 (15), 1.92 (9), 1.94 (4), 1.96 (0), 1.98 (1). What are (a) the mean height, (b) the root mean square height of the population? 21.4 Calculate the ratio of the thermal conductivities of gaseous hydrogen at 300 K to gaseous hydrogen at 10 K. Be circumspect, and think about the modes of motion that are thermally active at the two temperatures. 21.5 A Knudsen cell was used to determine the vapour pressure of germanium at 1000°C. During an interval of 7200 s the mass loss through a hole of radius 0.50 mm amounted to 43 µg. What is the vapour pressure of germanium at 1000°C? Assume the gas to be monatomic. 21.6 The nuclide 244 Bk (berkelium) decays by producing α particles, which capture electrons and form He atoms. Its half-life is 4.4 h. A sample of mass 1.0 mg was placed in a container of volume 1.0 cm3 that was impermeable to α radiation, but there was also a hole of radius 2.0 µm in the wall. What is the pressure of helium at 298 K, inside the container after (a) 1.0 h, (b) 10 h? 21.7 An atomic beam is designed to function with (a) cadmium, (b) mercury. The source is an oven maintained at 380 K, there being a small slit of dimensions 1.0 cm × 1.0 × 10−3 cm. The vapour pressure of cadmium is 0.13 Pa and that of mercury is 12 Pa at this temperature. What is the atomic current (the number of atoms per unit time) in the beams? 21.8 Conductivities are often measured by comparing the resistance of a cell filled with the sample to its resistance when filled with some standard solution, such as aqueous potassium chloride. The conductivity of water is 76 mS m−1 at 25°C and the conductivity of 0.100 mol dm−3 KCl(aq) is 1.1639 S m−1 . A cell had a resistance of 33.21 Ω when filled with 0.100 mol dm−3 KCl(aq) and 300.0 Ω when filled with 0.100 mol dm−3 CH3COOH. What is the molar conductivity of acetic acid at that concentration and temperature? 21.9 The resistances of a series of aqueous NaCl solutions, formed by successive dilution of a sample, were measured in a cell with cell constant (the constant C in the relation κ = C/R) equal to 0.2063 cm−1 . The following values were found: c/(mol dm−3 ) 0.00050 0.0010 0.0050 0.010 0.020 0.050 R/Ω 3314 1669 342.1 174.1 89.08 37.14 Verify that the molar conductivity follows the Kohlrausch law and find the limiting molar conductivity. Determine the coefficient K . Use the value of K (which should depend only on the nature, not the identity of the ions) and the information that λ(Na+ ) = 5.01 mS m2 mol−1 and λ(I− ) = 7.68 mS m2 mol−1 to predict (a) the molar conductivity, (b) the conductivity, (c) the resistance it would show in the cell, of 0.010 mol dm−3 NaI(aq) at 25°C. 21.10 After correction for the water conductivity, the conductivity of a saturated aqueous solution of AgCl at 25°C was found to be 0.1887 mS m−1 . What is the solubility of silver chloride at this temperature? 21.11 What are the drift speeds of Li+ , Na+ , and K+ in water when a potential difference of 10 V is applied across a 1.00-cm conductivity cell? How long would it take an ion to move from one electrode to the other? In conductivity measurements it is normal to use alternating current: what are the displacements of the ions in (a) centimetres, (b) solvent diameters, about 300 pm, during a half cycle of 1.0 kHz applied potential? 21.12 The mobilities of H+ and Cl− at 25°C in water are 3.623 × 10−7 m2 s−1 V−1 and 7.91 × 10−8 m2 s−1 V−1 , respectively. What proportion of the current is carried by the protons in 10−3 m HCl(aq)? What fraction do they carry when the NaCl is added to the acid so that the solution is 1.0 mol dm−3 in the salt? Note how concentration as well as mobility governs the transport of current. 21.13 In a moving boundary experiment on KCl the apparatus consisted of a tube of internal diameter 4.146 mm, and it contained aqueous KCl at a concentration of 0.021 mol dm−3 . A steady current of 18.2 mA was passed, and the boundary advanced as follows: ∆t/s 200 400 600 800 1000 x/mm 64 128 192 254 318 Find the transport number of K+ , its mobility, and its ionic conductivity. 21.14 The proton possesses abnormal mobility in water, but does it behave normally in liquid ammonia? To investigate this question, a movingboundary technique was used to determine the transport number of NH4 + in liquid ammonia (the analogue of H3O+ in liquid water) at −40°C (J. Baldwin, J. Evans, and J.B. Gill, J. Chem. Soc. A, 3389 (1971)). A steady current of 5.000 mA was passed for 2500 s, during which time the boundary formed between mercury(II) iodide and ammonium iodide solutions in ammonia moved 286.9 mm in a 0.013 65 mol kg−1 solution and 92.03 mm in a 0.042 55 mol kg−1 solution. Calculate the transport number of NH4 + at these concentrations, and comment on the mobility of the proton in liquid ammonia. The bore of the tube is 4.146 mm and the density of liquid ammonia is 0.682 g cm−3 . 21.15 A dilute solution of potassium permanganate in water at 25°C was prepared. The solution was in a horizontal tube of length 10 cm, and at first there was a linear gradation of intensity of the purple solution from the left (where the concentration was 0.100 mol dm−3 ) to the right (where the concentration was 0.050 mol dm−3 ). What is the magnitude and sign of the thermodynamic force acting on the solute (a) close to the left face of the container, (b) in the middle, (c) close to the right face? Give the force per mole and force per molecule in each case. * Problems denoted with the symbol ‡ were supplied by Charles Trapp, Carmen Giunta, and Marshall Cady. PROBLEMS 789 21.16 Estimate the diffusion coefficients and the effective hydrodynamic radii of the alkali metal cations in water from their mobilities at 25°C. Estimate the approximate number of water molecules that are dragged along by the cations. Ionic radii are given Table 20.3. 21.17 Nuclear magnetic resonance can be used to determine the mobility of molecules in liquids. A set of measurements on methane in carbon tetrachloride showed that its diffusion coefficient is 2.05 × 10−9 m2 s−1 at 0°C and 2.89 × 10−9 m2 s−1 at 25°C. Deduce what information you can about the mobility of methane in carbon tetrachloride. 21.18 A concentrated sucrose solution is poured into a cylinder of diameter 5.0 cm. The solution consisted of 10 g of sugar in 5.0 cm3 of water. A further 1.0 dm3 of water is then poured very carefully on top of the layer, without disturbing the layer. Ignore gravitational effects, and pay attention only to diffusional processes. Find the concentration at 5.0 cm above the lower layer after a lapse of (a) 10 s, (b) 1.0 y. 21.19 In a series of observations on the displacement of rubber latex spheres of radius 0.212 µm, the mean square displacements after selected time intervals were on average as follows: t/s 30 60 90 120 1012 ͗x2 ͘/m2 88.2 113.5 128 144 These results were originally used to find the value of Avogadro’s constant, but there are now better ways of determining NA, so the data can be used to find another quantity. Find the effective viscosity of water at the temperature of this experiment (25°C). 21.20‡ A.K. Srivastava, R.A. Samant, and S.D. Patankar (J. Chem. Eng. Data 41, 431 (1996)) measured the conductance of several salts in a binary solvent mixture of water and a dipolar aprotic solvent 1,3-dioxolan-2-one (ethylene carbonate). They report the following conductances at 25°C in a solvent 80 per cent 1,3-dioxolan-2-one by mass: NaI c/(mmol dm−3 ) 32.02 20.28 12.06 8.64 2.85 1.24 0.83 Λm/(S cm2 mol−1 ) 50.26 51.99 54.01 55.75 57.99 58.44 58.67 KI c/(mmol dm−3 ) 17.68 10.8 87.19 2.67 1.28 0.83 0.19 Λm /(S cm2 mol−1 ) 42.45 45.91 47.53 51.81 54.09 55.78 57.42 Calculate Λ°m for NaI and KI in this solvent and λ°(Na) − λ°(K). Compare your results to the analogous quantities in aqueous solution using Table 21.5 in the Data section. 21.21‡ A. Fenghour, W.A. Wakeham, V. Vesovic, J.T.R. Watson, J. Millat, and E. Vogel (J. Phys. Chem. Ref. Data 24, 1649 (1995)) have compiled an extensive table of viscosity coefficients for ammonia in the liquid and vapour phases. Deduce the effective molecular diameter of NH3 based on each of the following vapour-phase viscosity coefficients: (a) η = 9.08 × 10−6 kg m−1 s−1 at 270 K and 1.00 bar; (b) η = 1.749 × 10−5 kg m−1 s−1 at 490 K and 10.0 bar. 21.22‡ G. Bakale, K. Lacmann, and W.F. Schmidt ( J. Phys. Chem. 100, 12477 (1996)) measured the mobility of singly charged C− 60 ions in a variety of nonpolar solvents. In cyclohexane at 22°C, the mobility is 1.1 cm2 V−1 s−1 . Estimate the effective radius of the C− 60 ion. The viscosity of the solvent is 0.93 × 10−3 kg m−1 s−1 . Comment. The researchers interpreted the substantial difference between this number and the van der Waals radius of neutral C60 in terms of a solvation layer around the ion. Theoretical problems 21.23 Start from the Maxwell–Boltzmann distribution and derive an expression for the most probable speed of a gas of molecules at a temperature T. Go on to demonstrate the validity of the equipartition conclusion that the average translational kinetic energy of molecules free to move in three dimensions is 3 –2kT. 21.24 Consider molecules that are confined to move in a plane (a twodimensional gas). Calculate the distribution of speeds and determine the mean speed of the molecules at a temperature T. 21.25 A specially constructed velocity-selector accepts a beam of molecules from an oven at a temperature T but blocks the passage of molecules with a speed greater than the mean. What is the mean speed of the emerging beam, relative to the initial value, treated as a one-dimensional problem? 21.26 What is the proportion of gas molecules having (a) more than, (b) less than the root mean square speed? (c) What are the proportions having speeds greater and smaller than the mean speed? 21.27 Calculate the fractions of molecules in a gas that have a speed in a range ∆v at the speed nc* relative to those in the same range at c* itself? This calculation can be used to estimate the fraction of very energetic molecules (which is important for reactions). Evaluate the ratio for n = 3 and n = 4. 21.28 Derive an expression that shows how the pressure of a gas inside an effusion oven (a heated chamber with a small hole in one wall) varies with time if the oven is not replenished as the gas escapes. Then show that t1/2, the time required for the pressure to decrease to half its initial value, is independent of the initial pressure. Hint. Begin by setting up a differential equation relating dp/dt to p = NkT/V, and then integrating it. 21.29 Show how the ratio of two transport numbers t′ and t″ for two cations in a mixture depends on their concentrations c′ and c″ and their mobilities u′ and u″. 21.30 Confirm that eqn 21.72 is a solution of the diffusion equation with the correct initial value. 21.31 The diffusion equation is valid when many elementary steps are taken in the time interval of interest, but the random walk calculation lets us discuss distributions for short times as well as for long. Use eqn 21.84 to calculate the probability of being six paces from the origin (that is, at x = 6λ) after (a) four, (b) six, (c) twelve steps. 21.32 Use mathematical software to calculate P in a one-dimensional random walk, and evaluate the probability of being at x = nλ for n = 6, 10, 14, . . . , 60. Compare the numerical value with the analytical value in the limit of a large number of steps. At what value of n is the discrepancy no more than 0.1 per cent? 21.33 Supply the intermediate mathematical steps in Justification 21.7. 21.34‡ A dilute solution of a weak (1,1)-electrolyte contains both neutral ion pairs and ions in equilibrium (AB 5 A+ + B− ). Prove that molar conductivities are related to the degree of ionization by the equations: = + Λm(α) = λ+ + λ− = Λ°m − K(αc)1/2 where Λ°m is the molar conductivity at infinite dilution and K is the constant in Kohlrausch’s law (eqn 21.29). Applications: to astrophysics and biochemistry 21.35 Calculate the escape velocity (the minimum initial velocity that will take an object to infinity) from the surface of a planet of radius R. What is the value for (a) the Earth, R = 6.37 × 106 m, g = 9.81 m s−2 , (b) Mars, R = 3.38 × 106 m, mMars/mEarth = 0.108. At what temperatures do H2, He, and O2 molecules have mean speeds equal to their escape speeds? What proportion of the molecules have enough speed to escape when the temperature is (a) 240 K, (b) 1500 K? Calculations of this kind are very important in considering the composition of planetary atmospheres. (1 − α)Λ°m α2 Λm(α)2 1 Λm(α) 1 Λm 790 21 MOLECULES IN MOTION 21.36‡ Interstellar space is a medium quite different from the gaseous environments we commonly encounter on Earth. For instance, a typical density of the medium is about 1 atom cm−3 and that atom is typically H; the effective temperature due to stellar background radiation is about 10 000 K. Estimate the diffusion coefficient and thermal conductivity of H under these conditions. Comment. Energy is in fact transferred much more effectively by radiation. 21.37 The principal components of the atmosphere of the Earth are diatomic molecules, which can rotate as well as translate. Given that the translational kinetic energy density of the atmosphere is 0.15 J cm−3 , what is the total kinetic energy density, including rotation? 21.38‡ In the standard model of stellar structure (I. Nicholson, The sun. Rand McNally, New York (1982)), the interior of the Sun is thought to consist of 36 per cent H and 64 per cent He by mass, at a density of 158 g cm−3 . Both atoms are completely ionized. The approximate dimensions of the nuclei can be calculated from the formula rnucleus = 1.4 × 10−15 A1/3 m, where A is the mass number. The size of the free electron, re ≈ 10−18 m, is negligible compared to the size of the nuclei. (a) Calculate the excluded volume in 1.0 cm3 of the stellar interior and on that basis decide upon the applicability of the perfect gas law to this system. (b) The standard model suggests that the pressure in the stellar interior is 2.5 × 1011 atm. Calculate the temperature of the Sun’s interior based on the perfect gas model. The generally accepted standard model value is 16 MK. (c) Would a van der Waals type of equation (with a = 0) give a better value for T? 21.39 Enrico Fermi, the great Italian scientist, was a master at making good approximate calculations based on little or no actual data. Hence, such calculations are often called ‘Fermi calculations’. Do a Fermi calculation on how long it would take for a gaseous air-borne cold virus of molar mass 100 kg mol−1 to travel the distance between two conversing people 1.0 m a part by diffusion in still air. 21.40 The diffusion coefficient of a particular kind of t-RNA molecule is D = 1.0 × 10−11 m2 s−1 in the medium of a cell interior. How long does it take molecules produced in the cell nucleus to reach the walls of the cell at a distance 1.0 µm, corresponding to the radius of the cell? 21.41‡ In this problem, we examine a model for the transport of oxygen from air in the lungs to blood. First, show that, for the initial and boundary conditions c(x,t) = c(x,0) = c0, (0 < x < ∞) and c(0,t) = cs,(0 ≤ t ≤ ∞ ) where c0 and cs are constants, the concentration, c(x,t), of a species is given by c(x,t) = c0 + (cs − c0){1 − erfξ} ξ(x,t) = where erfξ is the error function (Justification 9.4) and the concentration c(x,t) evolves by diffusion from the yz-plane of constant concentration, such as might occur if a condensed phase is absorbing a species from a gas phase. Now draw graphs of concentration profiles at several different times of your choice for the diffusion of oxygen into water at 298 K (when D = 2.10 × 10−9 m2 s−1 ) on a spatial scale comparable to passage of oxygen from lungs through alveoli into the blood. Use c0 = 0 and set cs equal to the solubility of oxygen in water. Hint. Use mathematical software. x (4Dt)1/2 The rates of chemical reactions This chapter is the first of a sequence that explores the rates of chemical reactions. The chapter begins with a discussion of the definition of reaction rate and outlines the techniques for its measurement. The results of such measurements show that reaction rates depend on the concentration of reactants (and products) in characteristic ways that can be expressed in terms of differential equations known as rate laws. The solutions of these equations are used to predict the concentrations of species at any time after the start of the reaction. The form of the rate law also provides insight into the series of elementary steps by which a reaction takes place. The key task in this connection is the construction of a rate law from a proposed mechanism and its comparison with experiment. Simple elementary steps have simple rate laws, and these rate laws can be combined together by invoking one or more approximations. These approximations include the concept of the ratedetermining stage of a reaction, the steady-state concentration of a reaction intermediate, and the existence of a pre-equilibrium. This chapter introduces the principles of chemicalkinetics, the study of reaction rates, by showing how the rates of reactions may be measured and interpreted. The remaining chapters of this part of the text then develop this material in more detail and apply it to more complicated or more specialized cases. The rate of a chemical reaction might depend on variables under our control, such as the pressure, the temperature, and the presence of a catalyst, and we may be able to optimize the rate by the appropriate choice of conditions. The study of reaction rates also leads to an understanding of the mechanisms of reactions, their analysis into a sequence of elementary steps. Empirical chemical kinetics The first steps in the kinetic analysis of reactions are to establish the stoichiometry of the reaction and identify any side reactions. The basic data of chemical kinetics are then the concentrations of the reactants and products at different times after a reaction has been initiated. The rates of most chemical reactions are sensitive to the temperature, so in conventional experiments the temperature of the reaction mixture must be held constant throughout the course of the reaction. This requirement puts severe demands on the design of an experiment. Gas-phase reactions, for instance, are often carried out in a vessel held in contact with a substantial block of metal. Liquid-phase reactions, including flow reactions, must be carried out in an efficient thermostat. Special efforts have to be made to study reactions at low temperatures, as in the study of the kinds of reactions that take place in interstellar clouds. Thus, supersonic expansion of the reaction gas can be used to attain temperatures as low as 22 Empirical chemical kinetics 22.1 Experimental techniques 22.2 The rates of reactions 22.3 Integrated rate laws 22.4 Reactions approaching equilibrium 22.5 The temperature dependence of reaction rates Accounting for the rate laws 22.6 Elementary reactions 22.7 Consecutive elementary reactions I22.1 Impact on biochemistry: The kinetics of the helix–coil transition in polypeptides 22.8 Unimolecular reactions Checklist of key ideas Further reading Further information 22.1: The RRK model of unimolecular reactions Discussion questions Exercises Problems 792 22 THE RATES OF CHEMICAL REACTIONS 10 K. For work in the liquid phase and the solid phase, very low temperatures are often reached by flowing cold liquid or cold gas around the reaction vessel. Alternatively, the entire reaction vessel is immersed in a thermally insulated container filled with a cryogenic liquid, such as liquid helium (for work at around 4 K) or liquid nitrogen (for work at around 77 K). Non-isothermal conditions are sometimes employed. For instance, the shelf-life of an expensive pharmaceutical may be explored by slowly raising the temperature of a single sample. 22.1 Experimental techniques The method used to monitor concentrations depends on the species involved and the rapidity with which their concentrations change. Many reactions reach equilibrium over periods of minutes or hours, and several techniques may then be used to follow the changing concentrations. (a) Monitoring the progress of a reaction A reaction in which at least one component is a gas might result in an overall change in pressure in a system of constant volume, so its progress may be followed by recording the variation of pressure with time. Example 22.1 Monitoring the variation in pressure Predict how the total pressure varies during the gas-phase decomposition 2 N2O5(g) → 4 NO2(g) + O2(g) in a constant-volume container. Method The total pressure (at constant volume and temperature and assuming perfect gas behaviour) is proportional to the number of gas-phase molecules. Therefore, because each mole of N2O5 gives rise to 5 –2 mol of gas molecules, we can expect the pressure to rise to 5 –2 times its initial value. To confirm this conclusion, express the progress of the reaction in terms of the fraction, α, of N2O5 molecules that have reacted. Answer Let the initial pressure be p0 and the initial amount of N2O5 molecules present be n. When a fraction α of the N2O5 molecules has decomposed, the amounts of the components in the reaction mixture are: N2O5 NO2 O2 Total Amount: n(1 − α) 2αn 1 –2αn n(1 + 3 –2α) When α = 0 the pressure is p0, so at any stage the total pressure is p = (1 + 3 –2α)p0 When the reaction is complete, the pressure will have risen to 5 –2 times its initial value. Self-test 22.1 Repeat the calculation for 2 NOBr(g) → 2 NO(g) + Br2(g). [p = (1 + 1 –2α)p0] Spectrophotometry, the measurement of absorption of radiation in a particular spectral region, is widely applicable, and is especially useful when one substance in the reaction mixture has a strong characteristic absorption in a conveniently accessible region of the electromagnetic spectrum. For example, the progress of the reaction 22.1 EXPERIMENTAL TECHNIQUES 793 H2(g) + Br2(g) → 2 HBr(g) can be followed by measuring the absorption of visible light by bromine. A reaction that changes the number or type of ions present in a solution may be followed by monitoring the electrical conductivity of the solution. The replacement of neutral molecules by ionic products can result in dramatic changes in the conductivity, as in the reaction (CH3)3CCl(aq) + H2O(l) → (CH3)3COH(aq) + H+ (aq) + Cl− (aq) If hydrogen ions are produced or consumed, the reaction may be followed by monitoring the pH of the solution. Other methods of determining composition include emission spectroscopy, mass spectrometry, gas chromatography, nuclear magnetic resonance, and electron paramagnetic resonance (for reactions involving radicals or paramagnetic d-metal ions). (b) Application of the techniques In a real-time analysis the composition of the system is analysed while the reaction is in progress. Either a small sample is withdrawn or the bulk solution is monitored. In the flowmethod the reactants are mixed as they flow together in a chamber (Fig. 22.1). The reaction continues as the thoroughly mixed solutions flow through the outlet tube, and observation of the composition at different positions along the tube is equivalent to the observation of the reaction mixture at different times after mixing. The disadvantage of conventional flow techniques is that a large volume of reactant solution is necessary. This makes the study of fast reactions particularly difficult because to spread the reaction over a length of tube the flow must be rapid. This disadvantage is avoided by the stopped-flow technique, in which the reagents are mixed very quickly in a small chamber fitted with a syringe instead of an outlet tube (Fig. 22.2). The flow ceases when the plunger of the syringe reaches a stop, and the reaction continues in the mixed solutions. Observations, commonly using spectroscopic techniques such as ultraviolet–visible absorption, circular dichroism, and fluorescence emission, are made on the sample as a function of time. The technique allows for the study of reactions that occur on the millisecond to second timescale. The suitability of the stoppedflow method to the study of small samples means that it is appropriate for many biochemical reactions, and it has been widely used to study the kinetics of protein folding and enzyme action (see Impact I22.1 later in the chapter). Very fast reactions can be studied by flash photolysis, in which the sample is exposed to a brief flash of light that initiates the reaction and then the contents of the reaction chamber are monitored. Most work is now done with lasers with photolysis pulse widths that range from femtoseconds to nanoseconds (Section 14.5). The apparatus used for flash photolysis studies is based on the experimental design for time-resolved spectroscopy (Section 14.6). Reactions occurring on a picosecond or femtosecond timescale may be monitored by using electronic absorption or emission, infrared absorption, or Raman scattering. The spectra are recorded at a series of times following laser excitation. The laser pulse can initiate the reaction by forming a reactive species, such as an excited electronic state of a molecule, a radical, or an ion. We discuss examples of excited state reactions in Chapter 23. An example of radical generation is the light-induced dissociation of Cl2(g) to yield Cl atoms that react with HBr to make HCl and Br according to the following sequence: Cl2 + hν → Cl + Cl Cl + HBr → HCl* + Br HCl* + M → HCl + M Mixing chamber Driving syringes Movable spectrometer Mixing chamber Driving syringes Fixed spectrometer Stopping syringe Fig. 22.1 The arrangement used in the flow technique for studying reaction rates. The reactants are injected into the mixing chamber at a steady rate. The location of the spectrometer corresponds to different times after initiation. Fig. 22.2 In the stopped-flow technique the reagents are driven quickly into the mixing chamber by the driving syringes and then the time dependence of the concentrations is monitored. 794 22 THE RATES OF CHEMICAL REACTIONS Here HCl* denotes a vibrationally excited HCl molecule and M is a body (an unreactive molecule or the wall of the container) that removes the excess energy stored in HCl. A so-called ‘third body’ (M) is not always necessary for heteronuclear diatomic molecules because they can discard energy radiatively, but homonuclear diatomic molecules are vibrationally and rotationally inactive, and can discard energy only by collision. In contrast to real-time analysis, quenching methods are based on stopping, or quenching, the reaction after it has been allowed to proceed for a certain time. In this way the composition is analysed at leisure and reaction intermediates may be trapped. These methods are suitable only for reactions that are slow enough for there to be little reaction during the time it takes to quench the mixture. In the chemical quench flowmethod, the reactants are mixed in much the same way as in the flow method but the reaction is quenched by another reagent, such as solution of acid or base, after the mixture has travelled along a fixed length of the outlet tube. Different reaction times can be selected by varying the flow rate along the outlet tube. An advantage of the chemical quench flow method over the stopped-flow method is that spectroscopic fingerprints are not needed in order to measure the concentration of reactants and products. Once the reaction has been quenched, the solution may be examined by ‘slow’ techniques, such as gel electrophoresis, mass spectrometry, and chromatography. In the freeze quench method, the reaction is quenched by cooling the mixture within milliseconds and the concentrations of reactants, intermediates, and products are measured spectroscopically. 22.2 The rates of reactions Reaction rates depend on the composition and the temperature of the reaction mixture. The next few sections look at these observations in more detail. (a) The definition of rate Consider a reaction of the form A + 2 B → 3 C + D, in which at some instant the molar concentration of a participant J is [J] and the volume of the system is constant. The instantaneous rate of consumption of one of the reactants at a given time is −d[R]/dt, where R is A or B. This rate is a positive quantity (Fig. 22.3). The rate of formation of one of the products (C or D, which we denote P) is d[P]/dt (note the difference in sign). This rate is also positive. It follows from the stoichiometry for the reaction A + 2 B → 3 C + D that = 1 –3 = − = −1 –2 so there are several rates connected with the reaction. The undesirability of having different rates to describe the same reaction is avoided by using the extent of reaction, ξ (xi, the quantity introduced in Section 7.1): ξ = (22.1) where νJ is the stoichiometric number of species J, and defining the unique rate of reaction, v, as the rate of change of the extent of reaction: v = [22.2] It follows that v = × (22.3a) dnJ dt 1 V 1 νJ dξ dt 1 V nJ − nJ,0 νJ d[B] dt d[A] dt d[C] dt d[D] dt Molarconcentration,[J] Time, t (b) Tangent, rate slope= - (a) Tangent, rate slope= Reactant Product Time, t Fig. 22.3 The definition of (instantaneous) rate as the slope of the tangent drawn to the curve showing the variation of concentration with time. For negative slopes, the sign is changed when reporting the rate, so all reaction rates are positive. 22.2 THE RATES OF REACTIONS 795 (Remember that νJ is negative for reactants and positive for products.) For a homogeneous reaction in a constant-volume system the volume V can be taken inside the differential and we use [J] = nJ/V to write v = (22.3b) For a heterogeneous reaction, we use the (constant) surface area, A, occupied by the species in place of V and use σJ = nJ/A to write v = (22.3c) In each case there is now a single rate for the entire reaction (for the chemical equation as written). With molar concentrations in moles per cubic decimetre and time in seconds, reaction rates of homogeneous reactions are reported in moles per cubic decimetre per second (mol dm−3 s−1 ) or related units. For gas-phase reactions, such as those taking place in the atmosphere, concentrations are often expressed in molecules per cubic centimetre (molecules cm−3 ) and rates in molecules per cubic centimetre per second (molecules cm−3 s−1 ). For heterogeneous reactions, rates are expressed in moles per square metre per second (mol m−2 s−1 ) or related units. Illustration 22.1 Rates of formation and consumption If the rate of formation of NO in the reaction 2 NOBr(g) → 2 NO(g) + Br2(g) is reported as 0.16 mmol dm−3 s−1 , we use νNO = +2 to report that v = 0.080 mmol dm−3 s−1 . Because νNOBr = −2 it follows that d[NOBr]/dt = −0.16 mmol dm−3 s−1 . The rate of consumption of NOBr is therefore 0.16 mmol dm−3 s−1 , or 9.6 × 1016 molecules cm−3 s−1 . Self-test 22.2 The rate of change of molar concentration of CH3 radicals in the reaction 2 CH3(g) → CH3CH3(g) was reported as d[CH3]/dt = −1.2 mol dm−3 s−1 under particular conditions. What is (a) the rate of reaction and (b) the rate of formation of CH3CH3? [(a) 0.60 mol dm−3 s−1 , (b) 0.60 mol dm−3 s−1 ] (b) Rate laws and rate constants The rate of reaction is often found to be proportional to the concentrations of the reactants raised to a power. For example, the rate of a reaction may be proportional to the molar concentrations of two reactants A and B, so we write v = k[A][B] (22.4) with each concentration raised to the first power. The coefficient k is called the rate constant for the reaction. The rate constant is independent of the concentrations but depends on the temperature. An experimentally determined equation of this kind is called the rate law of the reaction. More formally, a rate law is an equation that expresses the rate of reaction as a function of the concentrations of all the species present in the overall chemical equation for the reaction at some time: v = f([A],[B], . . . ) [22.5a] For homogeneous gas-phase reactions, it is often more convenient to express the rate law in terms of partial pressures, which are related to molar concentrations by pJ = RT[J]. In this case, we write dσJ dt 1 νJ d[J] dt 1 νJ 796 22 THE RATES OF CHEMICAL REACTIONS v = f(pA,pB, . . . ) [22.5b] The rate law of a reaction is determined experimentally, and cannot in general be inferred from the chemical equation for the reaction. The reaction of hydrogen and bromine, for example, has a very simple stoichiometry, H2(g) + Br2(g) → 2 HBr(g), but its rate law is complicated: v = (22.6) In certain cases the rate law does reflect the stoichiometry of the reaction, but that is either a coincidence or reflects a feature of the underlying reaction mechanism (see later). A practical application of a rate law is that, once we know the law and the value of the rate constant, we can predict the rate of reaction from the composition of the mixture. Moreover, as we shall see later, by knowing the rate law, we can go on to predict the composition of the reaction mixture at a later stage of the reaction. Moreover, a rate law is a guide to the mechanism of the reaction, for any proposed mechanism must be consistent with the observed rate law. (c) Reaction order Many reactions are found to have rate laws of the form v = k[A]a [B]b · · · (22.7) The power to which the concentration of a species (a product or a reactant) is raised in a rate law of this kind is the order of the reaction with respect to that species. A reaction with the rate law in eqn 22.4 is first-order in A and first-order in B. The overall order of a reaction with a rate law like that in eqn 22.7 is the sum of the individual orders, a + b + · · · . The rate law in eqn 22.4 is therefore second-order overall. A reaction need not have an integral order, and many gas-phase reactions do not. For example, a reaction having the rate law v = k[A]1/2 [B] (22.8) is half-order in A, first-order in B, and three-halves-order overall. Some reactions obey a zero-order rate law, and therefore have a rate that is independent of the concentration of the reactant (so long as some is present). Thus, the catalytic decomposition of phosphine (PH3) on hot tungsten at high pressures has the rate law v = k (22.9) The PH3 decomposes at a constant rate until it has almost entirely disappeared. Zero-order reactions typically occur when there is a bottle-neck of some kind in the mechanism, as in heterogeneous reactions when the surface is saturated and the subsequent reaction slow and in a number of enzyme reactions when there is a large excess of substrate relative to the enzyme. When a rate law is not of the form in eqn 22.7, the reaction does not have an overall order and may not even have definite orders with respect to each participant. Thus, although eqn 22.6 shows that the reaction of hydrogen and bromine is first-order in H2, the reaction has an indefinite order with respect to both Br2 and HBr and has no overall order. These remarks point to three problems. First, we must see how to identify the rate law and obtain the rate constant from the experimental data. We concentrate on this aspect in this chapter. Second, we must see how to construct reaction mechanisms that are consistent with the rate law. We shall introduce the techniques of doing so in k[H2][Br2]3/2 [Br2] + k′[HBr] 22.2 THE RATES OF REACTIONS 797 this chapter and develop them further in Chapter 23. Third, we must account for the values of the rate constants and explain their temperature dependence. We shall see a little of what is involved in this chapter, but leave the details until Chapter 24. (d) The determination of the rate law The determination of a rate law is simplified by the isolation method in which the concentrations of all the reactants except one are in large excess. If B is in large excess, for example, then to a good approximation its concentration is constant throughout the reaction. Although the true rate law might be v = k[A][B], we can approximate [B] by [B]0, its initial value, and write v = k′[A] k′ = k[B]0 (22.10) which has the form of a first-order rate law. Because the true rate law has been forced into first-order form by assuming that the concentration of B is constant, eqn 22.10 is called a pseudofirst-order rate law. The dependence of the rate on the concentration of each of the reactants may be found by isolating them in turn (by having all the other substances present in large excess), and so constructing a picture of the overall rate law. In the method of initial rates, which is often used in conjunction with the isolation method, the rate is measured at the beginning of the reaction for several different initial concentrations of reactants. We shall suppose that the rate law for a reaction with A isolated is v = k[A]a ; then its initial rate, v0, is given by the initial values of the concentration of A, and we write v0 = k[A]0 a . Taking logarithms gives: log v0 = log k + a log [A]0 (22.11) For a series of initial concentrations, a plot of the logarithms of the initial rates against the logarithms of the initial concentrations of A should be a straight line with slope a. Example 22.2 Using the method of initial rates The recombination of iodine atoms in the gas phase in the presence of argon was investigated and the order of the reaction was determined by the method of initial rates. The initial rates of reaction of 2 I(g) + Ar(g) → I2(g) + Ar(g) were as follows: [I]0/(10−5 mol dm−3 ) 1.0 2.0 4.0 6.0 v0/(mol dm−3 s−1 ) (a) 8.70 × 10−4 3.48 × 10−3 1.39 × 10−2 3.13 × 10−2 (b) 4.35 × 10−3 1.74 × 10−2 6.96 × 10−2 1.57 × 10−1 (c) 8.69 × 10−3 3.47 × 10−2 1.38 × 10−1 3.13 × 10−1 The Ar concentrations are (a) 1.0 mmol dm−3 , (b) 5.0 mmol dm−3 , and (c) 10.0 mmol dm−3 . Determine the orders of reaction with respect to the I and Ar atom concentrations and the rate constant. Method Plot the logarithm of the initial rate, log v0, against log [I]0 for a given concentration of Ar, and, separately, against log [Ar]0 for a given concentration of I. The slopes of the two lines are the orders of reaction with respect to I and Ar, respectively. The intercepts with the vertical axis give log k. Answer The plots are shown in Fig. 22.4. The slopes are 2 and 1, respectively, so the (initial) rate law is v0 = k[I]2 0[Ar]0 This rate law signifies that the reaction is second-order in [I], first-order in [Ar], and third-order overall. The intercept corresponds to k = 9 × 109 mol−2 dm6 s−1 . 798 22 THE RATES OF CHEMICAL REACTIONS -1 -2 -3 log(/moldms)v0 --31 -1 -2 -3 0 00.2 0.20.4 0.40.6 0.60.8 0.81.0 1.0 log [I] 50 + log [Ar] 30 + (a) log(/moldms)v0 --31 (b) Fig. 22.4 The plot of log v0 against (a) log [I]0 for a given [Ar]0, and (b) log [Ar]0 for a given [I]0. A note on good practice The units of k come automatically from the calculation, and are always such as to convert the product of concentrations to a rate in concentration/time (for example, mol dm−3 s−1 ). Self-test 22.3 The initial rate of a reaction depended on concentration of a substance J as follows: [J]0/(mmol dm−3 ) 5.0 8.2 17 30 v0/(10−7 mol dm−3 s−1 ) 3.6 9.6 41 130 Determine the order of the reaction with respect to J and calculate the rate constant. [2, 1.4 × 10−2 dm3 mol−1 s−1 ] The method of initial rates might not reveal the full rate law, for once the products have been generated they might participate in the reaction and affect its rate. For example, products participate in the synthesis of HBr, because eqn 22.6 shows that the full rate law depends on the concentration of HBr. To avoid this difficulty, the rate law should be fitted to the data throughout the reaction. The fitting may be done, in simple cases at least, by using a proposed rate law to predict the concentration of any component at any time, and comparing it with the data. A law should also be tested by observing whether the addition of products or, for gas-phase reactions, a change in the surface-to-volume ratio in the reaction chamber affects the rate. 22.3 Integrated rate laws Because rate laws are differential equations, we must integrate them if we want to find the concentrations as a function of time. Even the most complex rate laws may be integrated numerically. However, in a number of simple cases analytical solutions, known as integrated rate laws, are easily obtained, and prove to be very useful. We examine a few of these simple cases here. (a) First-order reactions As shown in the Justification below, the integrated form of the first-order rate law = −k[A] (22.12a) d[A] dt 22.3 INTEGRATED RATE LAWS 799 is ln = −kt [A] = [A]0e−kt (22.12b) where [A]0 is the initial concentration of A (at t = 0). Justification 22.1 First-order integrated rate law First, we rearrange eqn 22.12a into = −kdt This expression can be integrated directly because k is a constant independent of t. Initially (at t = 0) the concentration of A is [A]0, and at a later time t it is [A], so we make these values the limits of the integrals and write Ύ [A] [A]0 = −kΎ t 0 dt Because the integral of 1/x is ln x, eqn 22.12b is obtained immediately. A note on good practice To set the limits of integration, identify the start time (t = 0) and the corresponding concentration of A ([A]0), and write these quantities as the lower limits of their respective integrals. Then identify the time of interest (t) and the corresponding concentration ([A]), and write these quantities as the upper limits of their respective integrals. Equation 22.12b shows that, if ln([A]/[A]0) is plotted against t, then a first-order reaction will give a straight line of slope −k. Some rate constants determined in this way are given in Table 22.1. The second expression in eqn 22.12b shows that in a firstorder reaction the reactant concentration decreases exponentially with time with a rate determined by k (Fig. 22.5). d[A] [A] d[A] [A] D F [A] [A]0 A C Synoptic table 22.1* Kinetic data for first-order reactions Reaction Phase q/°C k/s−1 t1/2 2 N2O5 → 4 NO2 + O2 g 25 3.38 × 10−5 5.70 h Br2(l) 25 4.27 × 10−5 4.51 h C2H6 → 2 CH3 g 700 5.36 × 10−4 21.6 min * More values are given in the Data section. Comment 22.1 The web site contains links to databases of rate constants of chemical reactions. 0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1 0 1 2 3 k tsmall[A]/[A]0 ksmall klarge Fig. 22.5 The exponential decay of the reactant in a first-order reaction. The larger the rate constant, the more rapid the decay: here klarge = 3ksmall. Exploration For a first-order reaction of the form A → nB (with n possibly fractional), the concentration of the product varies with time as [B] = n[B]0 (1 − e−kt ). Plot the time dependence of [A] and [B] for the cases n = 0.5, 1, and 2. Example 22.3 Analysing a first-order reaction The variation in the partial pressure of azomethane with time was followed at 600 K, with the results given below. Confirm that the decomposition CH3N2CH3(g) → CH3CH3(g) + N2(g) is first-order in azomethane, and find the rate constant at 600 K. t/s 0 1000 2000 3000 4000 p/Pa 10.9 7.63 5.32 3.71 2.59 800 22 THE RATES OF CHEMICAL REACTIONS 0 1000 2000 3000 4000 t/s -1.5 -1 -0.5 0 ln(/)pp0 Fig. 22.6 The determination of the rate constant of a first-order reaction: a straight line is obtained when ln [A] (or, as here, ln p) is plotted against t; the slope gives k. Method As indicated in the text, to confirm that a reaction is first-order, plot ln([A]/[A]0) against time and expect a straight line. Because the partial pressure of a gas is proportional to its concentration, an equivalent procedure is to plot ln(p/p0) against t. If a straight line is obtained, its slope can be identified with −k. Answer We draw up the following table: t/s 0 1000 2000 3000 4000 ln(p/p0) 1 −0.360 −0.720 −1.082 −1.441 Figure 22.6 shows the plot of ln(p/p0) against t. The plot is straight, confirming a first-order reaction, and its slope is −3.6 × 10−4 . Therefore, k = 3.6 × 10−4 s−1 . A note on good practice Because the horizontal and vertical axes of graphs are labelled with pure numbers, the slope of a graph is always dimensionless. For a graph of the form y = b + mx we can write y = b + (m units)(x/units) where ‘units’ are the units of x, and identify the (dimensionless) slope with ‘m units’. Then m = slope/units In the present case, because the graph shown here is a plot of ln(p/p0) against t/s (with ‘units’ = s) and k is the negative value of the slope of ln(p/p0) against t itself, k = −slope/s Self-test 22.4 In a particular experiment, it was found that the concentration of N2O5 in liquid bromine varied with time as follows: t/s 0 200 400 600 1000 [N2O5]/(mol dm−3 ) 0.110 0.073 0.048 0.032 0.014 Confirm that the reaction is first-order in N2O5 and determine the rate constant. [k = 2.1 × 10−3 s−1 ] (b) Half-lives and time constants A useful indication of the rate of a first-order chemical reaction is the half-life, t1/2, of a substance, the time taken for the concentration of a reactant to fall to half its initial value. The time for [A] to decrease from [A]0 to 1 –2[A]0 in a first-order reaction is given by eqn 22.12b as kt1/2 = −ln = −ln 1 −2 = ln 2 Hence t1/2 = (22.13) (ln 2 = 0.693.) The main point to note about this result is that, for a first-order reaction, the half-life of a reactant is independent of its initial concentration. Therefore, if the concentration of A at some arbitrary stage of the reaction is [A], then it will have fallen to 1 –2[A] after a further interval of (ln 2)/k. Some half-lives are given in Table 22.1. ln 2 k D F 1 −2[A]0 [A]0 A C 22.3 INTEGRATED RATE LAWS 801 Another indication of the rate of a first-order reaction is the time constant, τ (tau), the time required for the concentration of a reactant to fall to 1/e of its initial value. From eqn 22.12b it follows that kτ = −ln = −ln = 1 That is, the time constant of a first-order reaction is the reciprocal of the rate constant: τ = (22.14) (c) Second-order reactions We show in the Justification below that the integrated form of the second-order rate law = −k[A]2 (22.15a) is either of the following two forms: − = kt (22.15b) [A] = (22.15c) where [A]0 is the initial concentration of A (at t = 0). Justification 22.2 Second-order integrated rate law To integrate eqn 22.15a we rearrange it into = −kdt The concentration of A is [A0] at t = 0 and [A] at a general time t later. Therefore, −Ύ [A] [A]0 = kΎ t 0 dt Because the integral of 1/x2 is −1/x, we obtain eqn 22.15b by substitution of the limits [A] [A]0 = − = kt We can then rearrange this expression into eqn 22.15c. Equation 22.15b shows that to test for a second-order reaction we should plot 1/[A] against t and expect a straight line. The slope of the graph is k. Some rate constants determined in this way are given in Table 22.2. The rearranged form, eqn 22.15c, lets us predict the concentration of A at any time after the start of the reaction. It shows that the concentration of A approaches zero more slowly than in a first-order reaction with the same initial rate (Fig. 22.7). It follows from eqn 22.15b by substituting t = t1/2 and [A] = 1 –2[A]0 that the half-life of a species A that is consumed in a second-order reaction is 1 [A]0 1 [A] 1 [A] d[A] [A]2 d[A] [A]2 [A]0 1 + kt[A]0 1 [A]0 1 [A] d[A] dt 1 k 1 e D F [A]0/e [A]0 A C 1 0.8 0.6 0.4 0.2 0 0 1 2 3 [A]/[A]0 k tsmall 0[A] ksmall klarge Fig. 22.7 The variation with time of the concentration of a reactant in a secondorder reaction. The grey lines are the corresponding decays in a first-order reaction with the same initial rate. For this illustration, klarge = 3ksmall. Exploration For a second-order reaction of the form A → nB (with n possibly fractional), the concentration of the product varies with time as [B] = nkt[A]2 0/(1 + kt[A]0). Plot the time dependence of [A] and [B] for the cases n = 0.5, 1, and 2. 802 22 THE RATES OF CHEMICAL REACTIONS t1/2 = (22.16) Therefore, unlike a first-order reaction, the half-life of a substance in a secondorder reaction varies with the initial concentration. A practical consequence of this dependence is that species that decay by second-order reactions (which includes some environmentally harmful substances) may persist in low concentrations for long periods because their half-lives are long when their concentrations are low. In general, for an nth-order reaction of the form A → products, the half-life is related to the rate constant and the initial concentration of A by t1/2 = (22.17) (See Exercise 12.12a.) Another type of second-order reaction is one that is first-order in each of two reactants A and B: = −k[A][B] (22.18) Such a rate law cannot be integrated until we know how the concentration of B is related to that of A. For example, if the reaction is A + B → P, where P denotes products, and the initial concentrations are [A]0 and [B]0, then it is shown in the Justification below that, at a time t after the start of the reaction, the concentrations satisfy the relation ln = ([B]0 − [A]0)kt (22.19) Therefore, a plot of the expression on the left against t should be a straight line from which k can be obtained. Justification 22.3 Overall second-order rate law It follows from the reaction stoichiometry that, when the concentration of A has fallen to [A]0 − x, the concentration of B will have fallen to [B]0 − x (because each A that disappears entails the disappearance of one B). It follows that = −k([A]0 − x)([B]0 − x) Because [A] = [A]0 − x, it follows that d[A]/dt = −dx/dt and the rate law may be written as d[A] dt D F [B]/[B]0 [A]/[A]0 A C d[A] dt 1 k[A]n−1 1 k[A]0 Synoptic table 22.2* Kinetic data for second-order reactions Reaction Phase q/°C k/(dm3 mol−1 s−1 ) 2 NOBr → 2 NO + Br2 g 10 0.80 2 I → I2 g 23 7 × 109 CH3Cl + CH3O− CH3OH(l) 20 2.29 × 10−6 * More values are given in the Data section. 22.3 INTEGRATED RATE LAWS 803 = k([A]0 − x)([B]0 − x) The initial condition is that x = 0 when t = 0; so the integration required is Ύ x 0 = kΎ t 0 dt The integral on the right is simply kt. The integral on the left is evaluated by using the method of partial fractions and by using [A] = [A]0 and [B] = [B]0 at t = 0 to give: Ύ x 0 = ln − ln This expression can be simplified and rearranged into eqn 22.19 by combining the two logarithms by using ln y − ln z = ln(y/z) and noting that [A] = [A]0 − x and [B] = [B]0 − x. Similar calculations may be carried out to find the integrated rate laws for other orders, and some are listed in Table 22.3. 5 6 7 D E F [B]0 [B]0 − x A B C D E F [A]0 [A]0 − x A B C 1 2 3 1 [B]0 − [A]0 dx ([A]0 − x)([B]0 − x) dx ([A]0 − x)([B]0 − x) dx dt Comment 22.2 To use the method of partial fractions to evaluate an integral of the form Ύ dx, where a and b are constants, we write = − and integrate the expression on the right. It follows that Ύ = Ύ − Ύ = ln − ln + constant D E F 1 b − x 1 a − x A B C 1 b − a J K L dx b − x dx a − x G H I 1 b − a dx (a − x)(b − x) D E F 1 b − x 1 a − x A B C 1 b − a 1 (a − x)(b − x) 1 (a − x)(b − x) Table 22.3 Integrated rate laws Order Reaction Rate law* t1/2 0 A → P v = k [A]0/2k kt = x for 0 ≤ x ≤ [A]0 1 A → P v = k[A] (ln 2)/k kt = ln 2 A → P v = k[A]2 1/k[A]0 kt = A + B → P v = k[A][B] kt = ln A + 2 B → P v = k[A][B] kt = ln A → P with autocatalysis v = k[A][P] kt = ln 3 A + 2 B → P v = k[A][B]2 kt = + ln n ≥ 2 A → P v = k[A]n kt = − * x = [P] and v = dx/dt. 2n−1 − 1 (n − 1)k[A]0 n−1 5 6 7 1 [A]0 n−1 1 ([A]0 − x)n−1 1 2 3 1 n − 1 [A]0([B]0 − 2x) ([A]0 − x)[B]0 1 (2[A]0 − [B]0)2 2x (2[A]0 − [B]0)([B]0 − 2x)[B]0 [A]0([P]0 + x) ([A]0 − x)[P]0 1 [A]0 + [P]0 [A]0([B]0 − 2x) ([A]0 − x)[B]0 1 [B]0 − 2[A]0 [A]0([B]0 − x) ([A]0 − x)[B]0 1 [B]0 − [A]0 x [A]0([A]0 − x) [A]0 [A]0 − x 804 22 THE RATES OF CHEMICAL REACTIONS 22.4 Reactions approaching equilibrium Because all the laws considered so far disregard the possibility that the reverse reaction is important, none of them describes the overall rate when the reaction is close to equilibrium. At that stage the products may be so abundant that the reverse reaction must be taken into account. In practice, however, most kinetic studies are made on reactions that are far from equilibrium, and the reverse reactions are unimportant. (a) First-order reactions close to equilibrium We can explore the variation of the composition with time close to chemical equilibrium by considering the reaction in which A forms B and both forward and reverse reactions are first-order (as in some isomerizations). The scheme we consider is A → B v = k[A] (22.20) B → A v = k′[B] The concentration of A is reduced by the forward reaction (at a rate k[A]) but it is increased by the reverse reaction (at a rate k′[B]). The net rate of change is therefore = −k[A] + k′[B] (22.21) If the initial concentration of A is [A]0, and no B is present initially, then at all times [A] + [B] = [A]0. Therefore, = −k[A] + k′([A]0 − [A]) = −(k + k′)[A] + k′[A]0 (22.22) The solution of this first-order differential equation (as may be checked by differentiation) is [A] = [A]0 (22.23) Figure 22.8 shows the time dependence predicted by this equation. As t → ∞, the concentrations reach their equilibrium values, which are given by eqn 22.23 as: [A]eq = [B]eq = [A]0 − [A]∞ = (22.24) It follows that the equilibrium constant of the reaction is K = = (22.25) (This expression is only approximate because thermodynamic equilibrium constants are expressed in terms of activities, not concentrations.) Exactly the same conclusion can be reached—more simply, in fact—by noting that, at equilibrium, the forward and reverse rates must be the same, so k[A]eq = k′[B]eq (22.26) This relation rearranges into eqn 22.25. The theoretical importance of eqn 22.25 is that it relates a thermodynamic quantity, the equilibrium constant, to quantities relating to rates. Its practical importance is that, if one of the rate constants can be measured, then the other may be obtained if the equilibrium constant is known. k k′ [B]eq [A]eq k[A]0 k + k′ k′[A]0 k + k′ k′ + ke−(k+k′)t k′ + k d[A] dt d[A] dt 0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1 0 1 2 3 ( )k k' t+ [J]/[J]0 [A]/[A]0 [B]/[B]0 Fig. 22.8 The approach of concentrations to their equilibrium values as predicted by eqn 22.23 for a reaction A 5 B that is firstorder in each direction, and for which k = 2k′. Exploration Set up the rate equations and plot the corresponding graphs for the approach to and equilibrium of the form A 5 2 B. 22.4 REACTIONS APPROACHING EQUILIBRIUM 805 For a more general reaction, the overall equilibrium constant can be expressed in terms of the rate constants for all the intermediate stages of the reaction mechanism: K = × × · · · (22.27) where the ks are the rate constants for the individual steps and the k′s are those for the corresponding reverse steps. (b) Relaxation methods The term relaxation denotes the return of a system to equilibrium. It is used in chemical kinetics to indicate that an externally applied influence has shifted the equilibrium position of a reaction, normally suddenly, and that the reaction is adjusting to the equilibrium composition characteristic of the new conditions (Fig. 22.9). We shall consider the response of reaction rates to a temperature jump, a sudden change in temperature. We know from Section 7.4 that the equilibrium composition of a reaction depends on the temperature (provided ∆rH7 is nonzero), so a shift in temperature acts as a perturbation on the system. One way of achieving a temperature jump is to discharge a capacitor through a sample made conducting by the addition of ions, but laser or microwave discharges can also be used. Temperature jumps of between 5 and 10 K can be achieved in about 1 µs with electrical discharges. The high energy output of pulsed lasers (Section 14.5) is sufficient to generate temperature jumps of between 10 and 30 K within nanoseconds in aqueous samples. Some equilibria are also sensitive to pressure, and pressure-jump techniques may then also be used. When a sudden temperature increase is applied to a simple A 5 B equilibrium that is first-order in each direction, we show in the Justification below that the composition relaxes exponentially to the new equilibrium composition: x = x0e−t/τ = ka + kb (22.28) where x0 is the departure from equilibrium immediately after the temperature jump and x is the departure from equilibrium at the new temperature after a time t. Justification 22.4 Relaxation to equilibrium When the temperature of a system at equilibrium is increased suddenly, the rate constants change from their earlier values to the new values ka and kb characteristic of that temperature, but the concentrations of A and B remain for an instant at their old equilibrium values. As the system is no longer at equilibrium, it readjusts to the new equilibrium concentrations, which are now given by ka[A]eq = kb[B]eq and it does so at a rate that depends on the new rate constants. We write the deviation of [A] from its new equilibrium value as x, so [A] = x + [A]eq and [B] = [B]eq − x. The concentration of A then changes as follows: = −ka[A] + kb[B] = −ka([A]eq + x) + kb([B]eq − x) = −(ka + kb)x because the two terms involving the equilibrium concentrations cancel. Because d[A]/dt = dx/dt, this equation is a first-order differential equation with the solution that resembles eqn 22.12b and is given in eqn 22.28. d[A] dt 1 τ kb k′b ka k′a T1 Concentration,[A] Time, t T2 Exponential relaxation Fig. 22.9 The relaxation to the new equilibrium composition when a reaction initially at equilibrium at a temperature T1 is subjected to a sudden change of temperature, which takes it to T2. 806 22 THE RATES OF CHEMICAL REACTIONS Equation 22.28 shows that the concentrations of A and B relax into the new equilibrium at a rate determined by the sum of the two new rate constants. Because the equilibrium constant under the new conditions is K ≈ ka/kb, its value may be combined with the relaxation time measurement to find the individual ka and kb. Example 22.4 Analysing a temperature-jump experiment The equilibrium constant for the autoprotolysis of water, H2O(l) 5 H+ (aq) + OH− (aq), is Kw = a(H+ )a(OH− ) = 1.008 × 10−14 at 298 K. After a temperature-jump, the reaction returns to equilibrium with a relaxation time of 37 µs at 298 K and pH ≈ 7. Given that the forward reaction is first-order and the reverse is secondorder overall, calculate the rate constants for the forward and reverse reactions. Method We need to derive an expression for the relaxation time, τ (the time constant for return to equilibrium), in terms of k1 (forward, first-order reaction) and k2 (reverse, second-order reaction). We can proceed as above, but it will be necessary to make the assumption that the deviation from equilibrium (x) is so small that terms in x2 can be neglected. Relate k1 and k2 through the equilibrium constant, but be careful with units because Kw is dimensionless. Answer The forward rate at the final temperature is k1[H2O] and the reverse rate is k2[H+ ][OH− ]. The net rate of deprotonation of H2O is = −k1[H2O] + k2[H+ ][OH− ] Wewrite[H2O]=[H2O]eq+x,[H+ ]=[H+ ]eq −x,and[OH− ]=[OH− ]eq −x,andobtain = −{k1 + k2([H+ ]eq + [OH− ]eq)}x − k1[H2O]eq + k2[H+ ]eq[OH− ]eq + k2x2 ≈ −{k1 + k2([H+ ]eq + [OH− ]eq)}x where we have neglected the term in x2 and used the equilibrium condition k1[H2O]eq = k2[H+ ]eq[OH− ]eq to eliminate the terms that are independent of x. It follows that = k1 + k2([H+ ]eq + [OH− ]eq) At this point we note that Kw = a(H+ )a(OH− ) ≈ ([H+ ]eq/c7 )([OH− ]eq)/c7 ) = [H+ ]eq[OH− ]eq/c72 with c7 = 1 mol dm−3 . For this electrically neutral system, [H+ ] = [OH− ], so the concentration of each type of ion is Kw 1/2 c7 , and hence = k1 + k2(Kw 1/2 c7 + Kw 1/2 c7 ) = k2 + 2Kw 1/2 c7 At this point we note that = = The molar concentration of pure water is 55.6 mol dm−3 , so [H2O]eq/c7 = 55.6. If we write K = Kw/55.6 = 1.81 × 10−16 , we obtain = k2{K + 2Kw 1/2 }c7 1 τ Kwc72 [H2O]eq [H+ ]eq[OH− ]eq [H2O]eq k1 k2 5 6 7 k1 k2 1 2 3 1 τ 1 τ dx dt d[H2O] dt 22.5 THE TEMPERATURE DEPENDENCE OF REACTION RATES 807 lnk ln A 1/T Slope /= -E Ra Fig. 22.10 A plot of ln k against 1/T is a straight line when the reaction follows the behaviour described by the Arrhenius equation (eqn 22.29). The slope gives −Ea/R and the intercept at 1/T = 0 gives ln A. Synoptic table 22.4* Arrhenius parameters (1) First-order reactions A/s−1 Ea/(kJ mol−1 ) CH3NC → CH3CN 3.98 × 1013 160 2 N2O5 → 4 NO2 + O2 4.94 × 1013 103.4 (2) Second-order reactions A/(dm3 mol−1 s−1 ) Ea/(kJ mol−1 ) OH + H2 → H2O + H 8.0 ×1010 42 NaC2H5O + CH3I in ethanol 2.42 × 1011 81.6 * More values are given in the Data section. Hence, k2 = = = 1.4 × 1011 dm3 mol−1 s−1 It follows that k1 = k2Kc7 = 2.4 × 10−5 s−1 The reaction is faster in ice, where k2 = 8.6 × 1012 dm3 mol−1 s−1 . A note on good practice Notice how we keep track of units through the use of c7 : K and Kw are dimensionless; k2 is expressed in dm3 mol−1 s−1 and k1 is expressed in s−1 . Self-test 22.5 Derive an expression for the relaxation time of a concentration when the reaction A + B 5 C + D is second-order in both directions. [1/τ = k([A] + [B])eq + k′([C] + [D])eq] 22.5 The temperature dependence of reaction rates The rate constants of most reactions increase as the temperature is raised. Many reactions in solution fall somewhere in the range spanned by the hydrolysis of methyl ethanoate (where the rate constant at 35°C is 1.82 times that at 25°C) and the hydrolysis of sucrose (where the factor is 4.13). (a) The Arrhenius parameters It is found experimentally for many reactions that a plot of ln k against 1/T gives a straight line. This behaviour is normally expressed mathematically by introducing two parameters, one representing the intercept and the other the slope of the straight line, and writing the Arrhenius equation ln k = ln A − (22.29) The parameter A, which corresponds to the intercept of the line at 1/T = 0 (at infinite temperature, Fig. 22.10), is called the pre-exponential factor or the ‘frequency factor’. The parameter Ea, which is obtained from the slope of the line (−Ea/R), is called the activation energy. Collectively the two quantities are called the Arrhenius parameters (Table 22.4). Ea RT 1 (3.7 × 10−5 s) × (2.0 × 10−7 ) × (1 mol dm−3 ) 1 τ(K + 2Kw 1/2 )c7 808 22 THE RATES OF CHEMICAL REACTIONS 1.0 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 10 K/ 3 T -5 0 5 ln{/(dmmols)}k311-- Fig. 22.11 The Arrhenius plot using the data in Example 22.5. Example 22.5 Determining the Arrhenius parameters The rate of the second-order decomposition of acetaldehyde (ethanal, CH3CHO) was measured over the temperature range 700–1000 K, and the rate constants are reported below. Find Ea and A. T/K 700 730 760 790 810 840 910 1000 k/(dm3 mol−1 s−1 ) 0.011 0.035 0.105 0.343 0.789 2.17 20.0 145 Method According to eqn 22.29, the data can be analysed by plotting ln(k/dm3 mol−1 s−1 ) against 1/(T/K), or more conveniently (103 K)/T, and getting a straight line. As explained in Example 22.3, we obtain the activation energy from the dimensionless slope by writing −Ea/R = slope/units, where in this case ‘units’ = 1/(103 K), so Ea = −slope × R × 103 K. The intercept at T = 0 is ln(A/dm3 mol−1 s−1 ). Answer We draw up the following table: (103 K)/T 1.43 1.37 1.32 1.27 1.23 1.19 1.10 1.00 ln(k/dm3 mol−1 s−1 ) −4.51 −3.35 −2.25 −1.07 −0.24 0.77 3.00 4.98 Now plot ln k against 1/T (Fig. 22.11). The least-squares fit is to a line with slope −22.7 and intercept 27.7. Therefore, Ea = 22.7 × (8.3145 J K−1 mol−1 ) × 103 K = 189 kJ mol−1 A = e27.7 dm3 mol−1 s−1 = 1.1 × 1012 dm3 mol−1 s−1 A note on good practice Note that A has the same units as k. In practice, A is obtained from one of the mid-range data values rather than using a lengthy extrapolation. Self-test 22.6 Determine A and Ea from the following data: T/K 300 350 400 450 500 k/(dm3 mol−1 s−1 ) 7.9 × 106 3.0 × 107 7.9 × 107 1.7 × 108 3.2 ×108 [8 ×1010 dm3 mol−1 s−1 , 23 kJ mol−1 ] The fact that Ea is given by the slope of the plot of ln k against 1/T means that, the higher the activation energy, the stronger the temperature dependence of the rate constant (that is, the steeper the slope). A high activation energy signifies that the rate constant depends strongly on temperature. If a reaction has zero activation energy, its rate is independent of temperature. In some cases the activation energy is negative, which indicates that the rate decreases as the temperature is raised. We shall see that such behaviour is a signal that the reaction has a complex mechanism. The temperature dependence of some reactions is non-Arrhenius, in the sense that a straight line is not obtained when ln k is plotted against 1/T. However, it is still possible to define an activation energy at any temperature as Ea = RT2 [22.30] This definition reduces to the earlier one (as the slope of a straight line) for a temperature-independent activation energy. However, the definition in eqn 22.30 is more general than eqn 22.29, because it allows Ea to be obtained from the slope (at the D F d ln k dT A C 22.6 ELEMENTARY REACTIONS 809 temperature of interest) of a plot of ln k against 1/T even if the Arrhenius plot is not a straight line. Non-Arrhenius behaviour is sometimes a sign that quantum mechanical tunnelling is playing a significant role in the reaction (Section 22.7f). (b) The interpretation of the parameters For the present chapter we shall regard the Arrhenius parameters as purely empirical quantities that enable us to discuss the variation of rate constants with temperature; however, it is useful to have an interpretation in mind and write eqn 22.29 as k = Ae−Ea/RT (22.31) To interpret Ea we consider how the molecular potential energy changes in the course of a chemical reaction that begins with a collision between molecules of A and molecules of B (Fig. 22.12). As the reaction event proceeds, A and B come into contact, distort, and begin to exchange or discard atoms. The reactioncoordinate is the collection of motions, such as changes in interatomic distances and bond angles, that are directly involved in the formation of products from reactants. (The reaction coordinate is essentially a geometrical concept and quite distinct from the extent of reaction.) The potential energy rises to a maximum and the cluster of atoms that corresponds to the region close to the maximum is called the activated complex. After the maximum, the potential energy falls as the atoms rearrange in the cluster and reaches a value characteristic of the products. The climax of the reaction is at the peak of the potential energy, which corresponds to the activation energy Ea. Here two reactant molecules have come to such a degree of closeness and distortion that a small further distortion will send them in the direction of products. This crucial configuration is called the transition state of the reaction. Although some molecules entering the transition state might revert to reactants, if they pass through this configuration then it is inevitable that products will emerge from the encounter. We also conclude from the preceding discussion that, for a reaction involving the collision of two molecules, the activation energy is the minimum kinetic energy that reactants must have in order to form products. For example, in a gas-phase reaction there are numerous collisions each second, but only a tiny proportion are sufficiently energetic to lead to reaction. The fraction of collisions with a kinetic energy in excess of an energy Ea is given by the Boltzmann distribution as e−Ea/RT . Hence, we can interpret the exponential factor in eqn 22.31 as the fraction of collisions that have enough kinetic energy to lead to reaction. The pre-exponential factor is a measure of the rate at which collisions occur irrespective of their energy. Hence, the product of A and the exponential factor, e−Ea/RT , gives the rate of successful collisions. We shall develop these remarks in Chapter 24 and see that they have their analogues for reactions that take place in liquids. Accounting for the rate laws We now move on to the second stage of the analysis of kinetic data, their explanation in terms of a postulated reaction mechanism. 22.6 Elementary reactions Most reactions occur in a sequence of steps called elementary reactions, each of which involves only a small number of molecules or ions. A typical elementary reaction is Comment 22.3 The terms actiVated complex and transition state are often used as synonyms; however, we shall preserve a distinction. Ea Reactants Products Potentialenergy Progress of reaction Fig. 22.12 A potential energy profile for an exothermic reaction. The height of the barrier between the reactants and products is the activation energy of the reaction. 810 22 THE RATES OF CHEMICAL REACTIONS H + Br2 → HBr + Br Note that the phase of the species is not specified in the chemical equation for an elementary reaction, and the equation represents the specific process occurring to individual molecules. This equation, for instance, signifies that an H atom attacks a Br2 molecule to produce an HBr molecule and a Br atom. The molecularity of an elementary reaction is the number of molecules coming together to react in an elementary reaction. In a unimolecular reaction, a single molecule shakes itself apart or its atoms into a new arrangement, as in the isomerization of cyclopropane to propene. In a bimolecular reaction, a pair of molecules collide and exchange energy, atoms, or groups of atoms, or undergo some other kind of change. It is most important to distinguish molecularity from order: reaction order is an empirical quantity, and obtained from the experimental rate law; molecularity refers to an elementary reaction proposed as an individual step in a mechanism. The rate law of a unimolecular elementary reaction is first-order in the reactant: A → P = −k[A] (22.32) where P denotes products (several different species may be formed). A unimolecular reaction is first-order because the number of A molecules that decay in a short interval is proportional to the number available to decay. (Ten times as many decay in the same interval when there are initially 1000 A molecules as when there are only 100 present.) Therefore, the rate of decomposition of A is proportional to its molar concentration. An elementary bimolecular reaction has a second-order rate law: A + B → P = −k[A][B] (22.33) A bimolecular reaction is second-order because its rate is proportional to the rate at which the reactant species meet, which in turn is proportional to their concentrations. Therefore, if we have evidence that a reaction is a single-step, bimolecular process, we can write down the rate law (and then go on to test it). Bimolecular elementary reactions are believed to account for many homogeneous reactions, such as the dimerizations of alkenes and dienes and reactions such as CH3I(alc) + CH3CH2O− (alc) → CH3OCH2CH3(alc) + I− (alc) (where ‘alc’ signifies alcohol solution). There is evidence that the mechanism of this reaction is a single elementary step CH3I + CH3CH2O− → CH3OCH2CH3 + I− This mechanism is consistent with the observed rate law v = k[CH3I][CH3CH2O− ] (22.34) We shall see below how to combine a series of simple steps together into a mechanism and how to arrive at the corresponding rate law. For the present we emphasize that, if the reaction is an elementary bimolecular process, then it has second-order kinetics, but if the kinetics are second-order, then the reaction might be complex. The postulated mechanism can be explored only by detailed detective work on the system, and by investigating whether side products or intermediates appear during the course of the reaction. Detailed analysis of this kind was one of the ways, for example, in which the reaction H2(g) + I2(g) → 2 HI(g) was shown to proceed by a complex mechanism. For d[A] dt d[A] dt 22.7 CONSECUTIVE ELEMENTARY REACTIONS 811 many years the reaction had been accepted on good, but insufficiently meticulous evidence as a fine example of a simple bimolecular reaction, H2 + I2 → HI + HI, in which atoms exchanged partners during a collision. 22.7 Consecutive elementary reactions Some reactions proceed through the formation of an intermediate (I), as in the consecutive unimolecular reactions A ka −→ I kb −→ P An example is the decay of a radioactive family, such as 239 U 23.5 min −−−−−→ 239 Np 2.35 day −−−−−−→ 239 Pu (The times are half-lives.) We can discover the characteristics of this type of reaction by setting up the rate laws for the net rate of change of the concentration of each substance. (a) The variation of concentrations with time The rate of unimolecular decomposition of A is = −ka[A] (22.35) and A is not replenished. The intermediate I is formed from A (at a rate ka[A]) but decays to P (at a rate kb[I]). The net rate of formation of I is therefore = ka[A] − kb[I] (22.36) The product P is formed by the unimolecular decay of I: = kb[I] (22.37) We suppose that initially only A is present, and that its concentration is [A]0. The first of the rate laws, eqn 22.35, is an ordinary first-order decay, so we can write [A] = [A]0e−kat (22.38) When this equation is substituted into eqn 22.36, we obtain after rearrangement + kb[I] = ka[A]0e−kat (22.39) This differential equation has a standard form and, after setting [I]0 = 0, the solution is [I] = (e−kat − e−kbt )[A]0 (22.40) At all times [A] + [I] + [P] = [A]0, so it follows that [P] = 1 + [A]0 (22.41) The concentration of the intermediate I rises to a maximum and then falls to zero (Fig. 22.13). The concentration of the product P rises from zero towards [A]0. 5 6 7 kae−kbt − kbe−kat kb − ka 1 2 3 ka kb − ka d[I] dt d[P] dt d[I] dt d[A] dt Comment 22.4 The solution of a first-order differential equation with the form + yf(x) = g(x) is e∫f(x)dx y = Ύe∫f(x)dx g(x)dx + constant Equation 22.39 is a special case of this standard form, with f(x) = constant. dy dx 0 0.5 1 1.5 2 2.5 3 k ta 0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1 [J]/[J]0 [A]/[A]0 [I]/[A]0 [P]/[A]0 Fig. 22.13 The concentrations of A, I, and P in the consecutive reaction scheme A → I → P. The curves are plots of eqns 22.38, 22.40, and 21.41 with ka = 10kb. If the intermediate I is in fact the desired product, it is important to be able to predict when its concentration is greatest; see Example 22.6. Exploration Use mathematical software, an electronic spreadsheet, or the applets found in the Living graphs section of the text’s web site to investigate the effects on [A], [I], [P], and tmax of changing the ratio ka/kb from 10 (as in Fig. 22.13) to 0.01. Compare your results with those shown in Fig. 22.15. 812 22 THE RATES OF CHEMICAL REACTIONS Reactants Products Intermediates Concentration,[J] Time, t Fig. 22.14 The basis of the steady-state approximation. It is supposed that the concentrations of intermediates remain small and hardly change during most of the course of the reaction. Example 22.6 Analysing consecutive reactions Suppose that in an industrial batch process a substance A produces the desired compound I which goes on to decay to a worthless product C, each step of the reaction being first-order. At what time will I be present in greatest concentration? Method The time-dependence of the concentration of I is given by eqn 22.40. We can find the time at which [I] passes through a maximum, tmax, by calculating d[I]/dt and setting the resulting rate equal to zero. Answer It follows from eqn 22.40 that = − This rate is equal to zero when kae−kat = kbe−kbt Therefore, tmax = ln For a given value of ka, as kb increases both the time at which [I] is a maximum and the yield of I decrease. Self-test 22.7 Calculate the maximum concentration of I and justify the last remark. [[I]max/[A]0 = (ka/kb)c , c = kb/(kb − ka)] (b) The steady-state approximation One feature of the calculation so far has probably not gone unnoticed: there is a considerable increase in mathematical complexity as soon as the reaction mechanism has more than a couple of steps. A reaction scheme involving many steps is nearly always unsolvable analytically, and alternative methods of solution are necessary. One approach is to integrate the rate laws numerically (see Appendix 2). An alternative approach, which continues to be widely used because it leads to convenient expressions and more readily digestible results, is to make an approximation. The steady-state approximation (which is also widely called the quasi-steadystate approximation, QSSA, to distinguish it from a true steady state) assumes that, after an initial induction period, an interval during which the concentrations of intermediates, I, rise from zero, and during the major part of the reaction, the rates of change of concentrations of all reaction intermediates are negligibly small (Fig. 22.14): ≈ 0 (22.42) This approximation greatly simplifies the discussion of reaction schemes. For example, when we apply the approximation to the consecutive first-order mechanism, we set d[I]/dt = 0 in eqn 22.36, which then becomes ka[A] − kb[I] ≈ 0 Then [I] ≈ (ka/kb)[A] (22.43) d[I] dt ka kb 1 ka − kb ka[A]0(kae−kat − kbe−kbt ) kb − ka d[I] dt 22.7 CONSECUTIVE ELEMENTARY REACTIONS 813 0 1 2 30 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1 [J]/[J]0 k ta [A]/[A]0 [I]/[I]0 [P]/[P]0 Fig. 22.15 A comparison of the exact result for the concentrations of a consecutive reaction and the concentrations obtained by using the steady-state approximation (red lines) for kb = 20ka. (The curve for [A] is unchanged.) For this expression to be consistent with eqn 22.42, we require ka/kb << 1 (so that, even though [A] does depend on the time, the dependence of [I] on the time is negligible). On substituting this value of [I] into eqn 22.37, that equation becomes = kb[I] ≈ ka[A] (22.44) and we see that P is formed by a first-order decay of A, with a rate constant ka, the rateconstant of the slower, rate-determining, step. We can write down the solution of this equation at once by substituting the solution for [A], eqn 22.38, and integrating: [P] = ka[A]0 Ύ t 0 e−kat dt = (1 − e−kat )[A]0 (22.45) This is the same (approximate) result as before, eqn 22.41, but much more quickly obtained. Figure 22.15 compares the approximate solutions found here with the exact solutionsfoundearlier:kb doesnothavetobeverymuchbiggerthanka fortheapproach to be reasonably accurate. Example 22.7 Using the steady-state approximation Devise the rate law for the decomposition of N2O5, 2 N2O5(g) → 4 NO2(g) + O2(g) on the basis of the following mechanism: N2O5 → NO2 + NO3 ka NO2 + NO3 → N2O5 ka′ NO2 + NO3 → NO2 + O2 + NO kb NO + N2O5 → NO2 + NO2 + NO2 kc A note on good practice Note that when writing the equation for an elementary reaction all the species are displayed individually; so we write A → B + B, for instance, not A → 2 B. Method First identify the intermediates (species that occur in the reaction steps but do not appear in the overall reaction) and write expressions for their net rates of formation. Then, all net rates of change of the concentrations of intermediates are set equal to zero and the resulting equations are solved algebraically. Answer The intermediates are NO and NO3; the net rates of change of their concentrations are = kb[NO2][NO3] − kc[NO][N2O5] ≈ 0 = ka[N2O5] − ka′[NO2][NO3] − kb[NO2][NO3] ≈ 0 The net rate of change of concentration of N2O5 is = −ka[N2O5] + k′a[NO2][NO3] − kc[NO][N2O5] d[N2O5] dt d[NO3] dt d[NO] dt d[P] dt 814 22 THE RATES OF CHEMICAL REACTIONS Reactants Products (a) (b) (c) Slow Fast Fast Slow Slow Fast Fast Fig. 22.16 In these diagrams of reaction schemes, heavy arrows represent fast steps and light arrows represent slow steps. (a) The first step is rate-determining; (b) the second step is rate-determining; (c) although one step is slow, it is not rate-determining because there is a fast route that circumvents it. Potentialenergy Progress of reaction Fast Slow Fast RDS Fig. 22.17 The reaction profile for a mechanism in which the first step (RDS) is rate-determining. and replacing the concentrations of the intermediates by using the equations above gives = − Self-test 22.8 Derive the rate law for the decomposition of ozone in the reaction 2 O3(g) → 3 O2(g) on the basis of the (incomplete) mechanism O3 → O2 + O ka O2 + O → O3 k′a O + O3 → O2 + O2 kb [d[O3]/dt = −kakb[O3]2 /(k′a[O2] + kb[O3])] (c) The rate-determining step Equation 22.45 shows that, when kb >> ka, then the formation of the final product P depends on only the smaller of the two rate constants. That is, the rate of formation of P depends on the rate at which I is formed, not on the rate at which I changes into P. For this reason, the step A → I is called the ‘rate-determining step’ of the reaction. Its existence has been likened to building a six-lane highway up to a single-lane bridge: the traffic flow is governed by the rate of crossing the bridge. Similar remarks apply to more complicated reaction mechanisms, and in general the rate-determining step is the slowest step in a mechanism and controls the overall rate of the reaction. However, the rate-determining step is not just the slowest step: it must be slow and be a crucial gateway for the formation of products. If a faster reaction can also lead to products, then the slowest step is irrelevant because the slow reaction can then be sidestepped (Fig. 22.16). The rate law of a reaction that has a rate-determining step can often be written down almost by inspection. If the first step in a mechanism is rate-determining, then the rate of the overall reaction is equal to the rate of the first step because all subsequent steps are so fast that once the first intermediate is formed it results immediately in the formation of products. Figure 22.17 shows the reaction profile for a mechanism of this kind in which the slowest step is the one with the highest activation energy. Once over the initial barrier, the intermediates cascade into products. However, a rate-determining step may also stem from the low concentration of a crucial reactant and need not correspond to the step with highest activation barrier. (d) Kinetic and thermodynamic control of reactions In some cases reactants can give rise to a variety of products, as in nitrations of mono-substituted benzene, when various proportions of the ortho-, meta-, and parasubstituted products are obtained, depending on the directing power of the original substituent. Suppose two products, P1 and P2, are produced by the following competing reactions: A + B → P1 Rate of formation of P1 = k1[A][B] A + B → P2 Rate of formation of P2 = k2[A][B] The relative proportion in which the two products have been produced at a given stage of the reaction (before it has reached equilibrium) is given by the ratio of the two rates, and therefore of the two rate constants: 2kakb[N2O5] k′a + kb d[N2O5] dt 22.7 CONSECUTIVE ELEMENTARY REACTIONS 815 = (22.46) This ratio represents the kinetic control over the proportions of products, and is a common feature of the reactions encountered in organic chemistry where reactants are chosen that facilitate pathways favouring the formation of a desired product. If a reaction is allowed to reach equilibrium, then the proportion of products is determined by thermodynamic rather than kinetic considerations, and the ratio of concentrations is controlled by considerations of the standard Gibbs energies of all the reactants and products. (e) Pre-equilibria From a simple sequence of consecutive reactions we now turn to a slightly more complicated mechanism in which an intermediate I reaches an equilibrium with the reactants A and B: A + B 5 I → P (22.47) The rate constants are ka and k′a for the forward and reverse reactions of the equilibrium and kb for the final step. This scheme involves a pre-equilibrium, in which an intermediate is in equilibrium with the reactants. A pre-equilibrium can arise when the rate of decay of the intermediate back into reactants is much faster than the rate at which it forms products; thus, the condition is possible when k′a >> kb but not when kb >> k′a. Because we assume that A, B, and I are in equilibrium, we can write K = K = (22.48) In writing these equations, we are presuming that the rate of reaction of I to form P is too slow to affect the maintenance of the pre-equilibrium (see the example below). The rate of formation of P may now be written: = kb[I] = kbK[A][B] (22.49) This rate law has the form of a second-order rate law with a composite rate constant: = k[A][B] k = kbK = (22.50) Example 22.8 Analysing a pre-equilibrium Repeat the pre-equilibrium calculation but without ignoring the fact that I is slowly leaking away as it forms P. Method Begin by writing the net rates of change of the concentrations of the substances and then invoke the steady-state approximation for the intermediate I. Use the resulting expression to obtain the rate of change of the concentration of P. Answer The net rates of change of P and I are = kb[I] = ka[A][B] − k′a[I] − kb[I] ≈ 0 d[I] dt d[P] dt kakb k′a d[P] dt d[P] dt ka k′a [I] [A][B] k2 k1 [P2] [P1] 816 22 THE RATES OF CHEMICAL REACTIONS Ea(C H)- Potentialenergy Reaction coordinate C DC HEa(C D)Fig. 22.18 Changes in the reaction profile when a C-H bond undergoing cleavage is deuterated. In this illustration, the C-H and C-D bonds are modelled as simple harmonic oscillators. The only significant change is in the zero-point energy of the reactants, which is lower for C-D than for C-H. As a result, the activation energy is greater for C-D cleavage than for C-H cleavage. The second equation solves to [I] ≈ When we substitute this result into the expression for the rate of formation of P, we obtain ≈ k[A][B] k = This expression reduces to that in eqn 22.50 when the rate constant for the decay of I into products is much smaller than that for its decay into reactants, kb << ka′. Self-test 22.9 Show that the pre-equilibrium mechanism in which 2 A 5 I (K) followed by I + B → P (kb) results in an overall third-order reaction. [d[P]/dt = kbK[A]2 [B]] (f) The kinetic isotope effect The postulation of a plausible mechanism requires careful analysis of many experiments designed to determine the fate of atoms during the formation of products. Observation of the kinetic isotope effect, a decrease in the rate of a chemical reaction upon replacement of one atom in a reactant by a heavier isotope, facilitates the identification of bond-breaking events in the rate-determining step. A primary kinetic isotope effect is observed when the rate-determining step requires the scission of a bond involving the isotope. A secondary kinetic isotope effect is the reduction in reaction rate even though the bond involving the isotope is not broken to form product. In both cases, the effect arises from the change in activation energy that accompanies the replacement of an atom by a heavier isotope on account of changes in the zero-point vibrational energies (Section 13.9). First, we consider the origin of the primary kinetic isotope effect in a reaction in which the rate-determining step is the scission of a C-H bond. The reaction coordinate corresponds to the stretching of the C-H bond and the potential energy profile is shown in Fig. 22.18. On deuteration, the dominant change is the reduction of the zero-point energy of the bond (because the deuterium atom is heavier). The whole reaction profile is not lowered, however, because the relevant vibration in the activated complex has a very low force constant, so there is little zero-point energy associated with the reaction coordinate in either isotopomeric form of the activated complex. We assume that, to a good approximation, a change in the activation energy arises only from the change in zero-point energy of the stretching vibration, so Ea(C-D) − Ea(C-H) = NA{1 –2hc#(C-H) − 1 –2hc#(C-D)} (22.51) where # is the relevant vibrational wavenumber. From Section 13.9, we know that #(C-D) = (µCH/µCD)1/2 #(C-H), where µ is the relevant effective mass. It follows that Ea(C-D) − Ea(C-H) = 1 –2NAhc#(C-H) 1 − 1/2 (22.52) If we assume further that the pre-exponential factor does not change upon deuteration, then the rate constants for the two species should be in the ratio 5 6 7 D F µCH µCD A C 1 2 3 kakb k′a + kb d[P] dt ka[A][B] k′a + kb 22.7 CONSECUTIVE ELEMENTARY REACTIONS 817 Potentialenergy Reaction coordinate Wavefunction Fig. 22.19 A proton can tunnel through the activation energy barrier that separates reactants from products, so the effective height of the barrier is reduced and the rate of the proton transfer reaction increases. The effect is represented by drawing the wavefunction of the proton near the barrier. Proton tunnelling is important only at low temperatures, when most of the reactants are trapped on the left of the barrier. Ea(C H)- Potentialenergy Reaction coordinate C DC HEa(C D)C HC DFig. 22.20 The difference in zero-point vibrational energies used to explain the secondary isotope effect. = e−λ with λ = 1 − 1/2 (22.53) Note that λ > 0 because µCD > µCH and that k(C-D)/k(C-H) decreases with decreasing temperature. Illustration 22.2 Assessing the primary kinetic isotope effect From infrared spectra, the fundamental vibrational wavenumber for stretching of a C-H bond is about 3000 cm−1 . From µCH/µCD = 0.538 and eqn 22.53, it follows that k(C-D)/k(C-H) = 0.145 at 298 K. We predict that at room temperature C-H cleavage should be about seven times faster than C-D cleavage, other conditions being equal. However, experimental values of k(C-D)/k(C-H) can differ significantly from those predicted by eqn 22.53 on account of the severity of the assumptions in the model. In some cases, substitution of deuterium for hydrogen results in values of k(C-D)/ k(C-H) that are too low to be accounted for by eqn 22.53, even when more complete models are used to predict ratios of rate constants. Such abnormal kinetic isotope effects are evidence for a path in which quantum mechanical tunnelling of hydrogen atoms takes place through the activation barrier (Fig. 22.19). We saw in Section 9.3 that the probability of tunnelling through a barrier decreases as the mass of the particle increases, so deuterium tunnels less efficiently through a barrier than hydrogen and its reactions are correspondingly slower. Quantum mechanical tunnelling can be the dominant process in reactions involving hydrogen atom or proton transfer when the temperature is so low that very few reactant molecules can overcome the activation energy barrier. We shall see in Chapter 23 that, because me is so small, tunnelling is also a very important contributor to the rates of electron transfer reactions. Now consider the secondary isotope effect, which arises from differences in the zero-point energies between reactants and an activated complex with a significantly different structure. The activation energy of the undeuterated compound is Ea(H) = Ea + E‡ vib,0(H) − Evib,0(H) where Ea is the difference between the minima of the molecular potential energy curves of the activated complex and the ground state of the reactant and E‡ vib,0(H) and Evib,0(H) are the zero-point vibrational energies of the two states (Fig. 22.20). For the deuterated compound Ea(D) = Ea + E‡ vib,0(D) − Evib,0(D) The difference in activation energies is therefore Ea(D) − Ea(H) = {E‡ vib,0(D) − Evib,0(D)} − {E‡ vib,0(H) − Evib,0(H)} We now suppose that the difference in zero-point energies is due solely to the vibration of a single C-H (or C-D) bond, and so write Ea(D) − Ea(H) = 1 –2NAhc{#‡ (C-D) − #(C-D)} − 1 –2NAhc{#‡ (C-H) − #(C-H)} (22.54) where #‡ and # denote vibrational wavenumbers in the activated complex and reactant, respectively. With #‡ (C-D) = (µCH/µCD)1/2 #‡ (C-H) and #(C-D) = (µCH/µCD)1/2 # (C-H), it follows that 5 6 7 D F µCH µCD A C 1 2 3 hc#(C-H) 2kT k(C-D) k(C-H) 818 22 THE RATES OF CHEMICAL REACTIONS Ea(D) − Ea(H) = 1 –2NAhc{#‡ (C-H) − #(C-H)} 1/2 − 1 (22.55) and = e−λ with λ = 1/2 − 1 (22.56) Because µCH/µCD < 1, provided the vibrational wavenumber of the activated complex is less than that of the reactant, λ > 1 and the deuterated form reacts more slowly than the undeuterated compound. Illustration 22.3 Assessing the secondary kinetic isotope effect In the heterolytic dissociation CHCl3 → CHCl2 + + Cl− the activated complex resembles the product CHCl2 + . From infrared spectra, the fundamental vibrational wavenumber for a bending motion involving the C-H group is about 1350 cm−1 in CHCl3 and about 800 cm−1 in CHCl2 + . Assuming that #‡ (C-H) = 800 cm−1 on account of the structural similarity between CHCl2 + and the activated complex, it follows from µCH/µCD = 0.538 and eqn 22.56 that k(D)/k(H) = 0.709 at 298 K. We predict that at room temperature the dissociation of CHCl3 should be about 40 per cent faster than dissociation of CDCl3. Comparison with the result from Illustration 22.2 shows that the secondary kinetic isotope effect leads to higher values of k(D)/k(H) than does the primary kinetic isotope effect. This conclusion is supported by a number of experimental observations. IMPACT ON BIOCHEMISTRY I22.1 Kinetics of the helix–coil transition in polypeptides We saw in Impact I16.1 that a simple statistical model accounts for the thermodynamic aspects of the helix–coil transition in polypeptides. The unfolding of a helix begins somewhere in the middle of the chain with a nucleation step, which is less favourable than the remaining helix-to-coil conversions, and continues in a cooperative fashion, in which the polymer becomes increasingly more susceptible to structural changes as more conversions occur. Here we examine the kinetics of the helix–coil transition, focusing primarily on experimental strategies and some recent results. Earlier work on folding and unfolding of small polypeptides and large proteins relied primarily on rapid mixing and stopped-flow techniques. In a typical stopped-flow experiment, a sample of the protein with a high concentration of a chemical denaturant, such as urea or guanidinium hydrochloride, is mixed with a solution containing a much lower concentration of the same denaturant. Upon entering the mixing chamber, the denaturant is diluted and the protein re-folds. Unfolding is observed by mixing a sample of folded protein with a solution containing a high concentration of denaturant. These experiments are ideal for sorting out events in the millisecond timescale, such as the formation of contacts between helical segments in a large protein. However, the available data also indicate that, in a number of proteins, a significant portion of the folding process occurs in less than 1 ms, a time range not accessible by the stopped-flow technique. More recent temperature-jump and flash photolysis experiments have uncovered faster events. For example, at ambient temperature the formation of a loop between helical or sheet segments may be as fast as 1 µs and the formation of tightly packed cores with significant tertiary structure occurs in the 5 6 7 D F µCH µCD A C 1 2 3 hc{#‡ (C-H) − #(C-H)} 2kT k(D) k(H) 5 6 7 D F µCH µCD A C 1 2 3 I22.1 IMPACT ON BIOCHEMISTRY: KINETICS OF THE HELIX–COIL TRANSITION IN POLYPEPTIDES 819 10–100 µs range. Among the fastest events are the formation and denaturation of helices and sheets from fully unfolded peptide chains and we examine how the laserinduced temperature-jump technique has been used in the study of the helix–coil transition. The laser-induced temperature-jump technique takes advantage of the fact that proteins unfold, or melt, at high temperatures and each protein has a characteristic melting temperature (Section 19.10). Proteins also lose their native structures at very low temperatures, a process known as cold denaturation, and re-fold when the temperature is increased but kept significantly below the melting temperature. Hence, a temperature-jump experiment can be configured to monitor either folding or unfolding of a polypeptide, depending on the initial and final temperatures of the sample. The challenge of using melting or cold denaturation as the basis of kinetic measurements lies in increasing the temperature of the sample very quickly so fast relaxation proccess can be monitored. A number of clever strategies have been employed. In one example, a pulsed laser excites dissolved dye molecules that decay largely by internal conversion, or heat transfer to the solution. Another variation makes use of direct excitation of overtones of the O-H or O-D stretching modes of H2O or D2O, respectively, with a pulsed infrared laser. The latter strategy leads to temperature jumps in a small irradiated volume of about 20 K in less than 100 ps. Relaxation of the sample can then be probed by a variety of spectroscopic techniques, including absorption, emission, or Raman scattering. For example, the infrared absorption spectrum of a polypeptide is sensitive to polypeptide conformation, as the N-H stretching vibrations in the range 1630–1670 cm−1 are significantly different in the helix and coil forms. Much of the kinetic work on the helix–coil transition has been conducted in small synthetic polypeptides rich in alanine, an aminoacid that is known to stabilize helical structures. Both experimental results and statistical mechanical calculations suggest that the mechanism of unfolding consists of at least two steps: a very fast step in which aminoacids at either end of a helical segment undergo transitions to coil regions and a slower rate-determining step that corresponds to the cooperative melting of the rest of the chain and loss of helical content. Using h and c to denote an aminoacid residue belonging to a helical and coil region, respectively, the mechanism may be summarized as follows: hhhh...→ chhh... very fast chhh... → cccc... rate-determining step The rate-determining step is thought to account for the relaxation time of 160 ns measured with a laser-induced temperature jump between 282.5 K and 300.6 K in an alanine-rich polypeptide containing 21 amino acids. It is thought that the limitation on the rate of the helix–coil transition in this peptide arises from an activation energy barrier of 1.7 kJ mol−1 associated with nucleation events of the form ...hhhh... → ...hhch... in the middle of the chain. Therefore, nucleation is not only thermodynamically unfavourable but also kinetically slow. Models that use concepts of statistical thermodynamics also suggest that a hhhh... → chhh... transition at either end of a helical segment has a significantly lower activation energy on account of the converting aminoacid not being flanked by h regions. The time constant for the helix–coil transition has also been measured in proteins. In apomyoglobin (myoglobin lacking the haem cofactor), the unfolding of the helices appears to have a relaxation time of about 50 ns, even shorter than in synthetic peptides. It is difficult to interpret these results because we do not yet know how the amino acid sequence or interactions between helices in a folded protein affect the helix–coil relaxation time. 820 22 THE RATES OF CHEMICAL REACTIONS 22.8 Unimolecular reactions A number of gas-phase reactions follow first-order kinetics, as in the isomerization of cyclopropane mentioned earlier: cyclo-C3H6 → CH3CH=CH2 v = k[cyclo-C3H6] (22.57) The problem with the interpretation of first-order rate laws is that presumably a molecule acquires enough energy to react as a result of its collisions with other molecules. However, collisions are simple bimolecular events, so how can they result in a first-order rate law? First-order gas-phase reactions are widely called ‘unimolecular reactions’ because they also involve an elementary unimolecular step in which the reactant molecule changes into the product. This term must be used with caution, though, because the overall mechanism has bimolecular as well as unimolecular steps. (a) The Lindemann–Hinshelwood mechanism The first successful explanation of unimolecular reactions was provided by Frederick Lindemann in 1921 and then elaborated by Cyril Hinshelwood. In the Lindemann– Hinshelwood mechanism it is supposed that a reactant molecule A becomes energetically excited by collision with another A molecule (Fig. 22.21): A + A → A* + A = ka[A]2 (22.58) The energized molecule (A*) might lose its excess energy by collision with another molecule: A + A* → A + A = −k′a[A][A*] (22.59) Alternatively, the excited molecule might shake itself apart and form products P. That is, it might undergo the unimolecular decay A* → P = −kb[A*] (22.60) If the unimolecular step is slow enough to be the rate-determining step, the overall reaction will have first-order kinetics, as observed. This conclusion can be demonstrated explicitly by applying the steady-state approximation to the net rate of formation of A*: = ka[A]2 − k′a[A][A*] − kb[A*] ≈ 0 (22.61) This equation solves to [A*] = (22.62) so the rate law for the formation of P is = kb[A*] = (22.63) At this stage the rate law is not first-order. However, if the rate of deactivation by (A*,A) collisions is much greater than the rate of unimolecular decay, in the sense that k′a[A*][A] >> kb[A*] or k′a[A] >> kb kakb[A]2 kb + k′a[A] d[P] dt ka[A]2 kb + k′a[A] d[A*] dt d[A*] dt d[A*] dt d[A*] dt Products A* A A A Fig. 22.21 A representation of the Lindemann–Hinshelwood mechanism of unimolecular reactions. The species A is excited by collision with A, and the excited A molecule (A*) may either be deactivated by a collision with A or go on to decay by a unimolecular process to form products. 22.8 UNIMOLECULAR REACTIONS 821 then we can neglect kb in the denominator and obtain = k[A] k = (22.64) Equation 22.64 is a first-order rate law, as we set out to show. The Lindemann–Hinshelwood mechanism can be tested because it predicts that, as the concentration (and therefore the partial pressure) of A is reduced, the reaction should switch to overall second-order kinetics. Thus, when k′a[A] << kb, the rate law in eqn 22.63 is ≈ ka[A]2 (22.65) The physical reason for the change of order is that at low pressures the rate-determining step is the bimolecular formation of A*. If we write the full rate law in eqn 22.63 as = k[A] k = (22.66) then the expression for the effective rate constant, k, can be rearranged to = + (22.67) Hence, a test of the theory is to plot 1/k against 1/[A], and to expect a straight line. (b) The RRK model Whereas the Lindemann–Hinshelwood mechanism agrees in general with the switch in order of unimolecular reactions, it does not agree in detail. Figure 22.22 shows a typical graph of 1/k against 1/[A]. The graph has a pronounced curvature, corresponding to a larger value of k (a smaller value of 1/k) at high pressures (low 1/[A]) than would be expected by extrapolation of the reasonably linear low pressure (high 1/[A]) data. An improved model was proposed in 1926 by O.K. Rice and H.C. Ramsperger and almost simultaneously by L.S. Kassel, and is now known as the Rice–Ramsperger– Kassel model (RRK model). The model has been elaborated, largely by R.A. Marcus, into the RRKM model. Here we outline Kassel’s original approach to the RRK model: the details are set out in Further information 22.1 at the end of the chapter. The essential feature of the model is that, although a molecule might have enough energy to react, that energy is distributed over all the modes of motion of the molecule, and reaction will occur only when enough of that energy has migrated into a particular location (such as a bond) in the molecule. Provided the rate constant is proportional to this probability, which we show in Further information 22.1 is P = 1 − s−1 (22.68a) where s is the number of modes of motion over which the energy may be dissipated and E* is the energy required for the bond of interest to break, we can write the Kassel form of the unimolecular rate constant for the decay of A* to products as kb(E) = 1 − s−1 kb for E ≥ E* (22.68b) where kb is the rate constant used in the original Lindemann theory. D F E* E A C D F E* E A C 1 ka[A] k′a kakb 1 k kakb[A] kb + k′a[A] d[P] dt d[P] dt kakb k′a d[P] dt (10s)/ --41 k 0 1 2 0 0.5 1 1.5 2 (10 mol dm )/[A]- -3 3 Fig. 22.22 The pressure dependence of the unimolecular isomerization of transCHD=CHD showing a pronounced departure from the straight line predicted by eqn 22.67 based on the Lindemann–Hinshelwood mechanism. 822 22 THE RATES OF CHEMICAL REACTIONS The energy dependence of the rate constant given by eqn 22.68 is shown in Fig. 22.23 for various values of s. We see that the rate constant is smaller at a given excitation energy if s is large, as it takes longer for the excitation energy to migrate through all the oscillators of a large molecule and accumulate in the critical mode. As E becomes very large, however, the term in parentheses approaches 1, and kb(E) becomes independent of the energy and the number of oscillators in the molecule, as there is now enough energy to accumulate immediately in the critical mode regardless of the size of the molecule. (c) The activation energy of a composite reaction Although the rate of each step of a complex mechanism might increase with temperature and show Arrhenius behaviour, is that true of a composite reaction? To answer this question, we consider the high-pressure limit of the Lindemann–Hinshelwood mechanism as expressed in eqn 22.64. If each of the rate constants has an Arrheniuslike temperature dependence, we can use eqn 22.31 for each of them, and write k = = (22.69) = e−{Ea(a)+Ea(b)−E′a(a)}/RT That is, the composite rate constant k has an Arrhenius-like form with activation energy Ea = Ea(a) + Ea(b) − E′a(a) (22.70) Provided Ea(a) + Ea(b) > E′a(a), the activation energy is positive and the rate increases with temperature. However, it is conceivable that Ea(a) + Ea(b) < E′a(a) (Fig. 22.24), in which case the activation energy is negative and the rate will decrease as the temperature is raised. There is nothing remarkable about this behaviour: all it means is that the reverse reaction (corresponding to the deactivation of A*) is so sensitive to temperature that its rate increases sharply as the temperature is raised, and depletes the steadystate concentration of A*. The Lindemann–Hinshelwood mechanism is an unlikely candidate for this type of behaviour because the deactivation of A* has only a small activation energy, but there are reactions with analogous mechanisms in which a negative activation energy is observed. When we examine the general rate law given in eqn 22.63, it is clear that the temperature dependence may be difficult to predict because each rate constant in the AaAb A′a (Aae−Ea(a)/RT )(Abe−Ea(b)/RT ) (A′ae−E′a(a)/RT ) kakb k′a 0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1 0 10 20 30 40 50 5 10 20 E E/ * kEkbb()/ Fig. 22.23 The energy dependence of the rate constant given by eqn 22.68 for three values of s. E aa( ) E aa( )E' aa ( ) E' aa ( ) E ba( ) E ba( ) Potentialenergy Reaction coordinate Reaction coordinate(a) (b) Potentialenergy Fig. 22.24 For a reaction with a preequilibrium, there are three activation energies to take into account, two referring to the reversible steps of the preequilibrium and one for the final step. The relative magnitudes of the activation energies determine whether the overall activation energy is (a) positive or (b) negative. FURTHER READING 823 expression for k increases with temperature, and the outcome depends on whether the terms in the numerator dominate those in the denominator, or vice versa. The fact that so many reactions do show Arrhenius-like behaviour with positive activation energies suggests that their rate laws are in a ‘simple’ regime, like eqn 22.65 rather than eqn 22.64, and that the temperature dependence is dominated by the activation energy of the rate-determining stage. Checklist of key ideas 1. The rates of chemical reactions are measured by using techniques that monitor the concentrations of species present in the reaction mixture. Examples include real-time and quenching procedures, flow and stopped-flow techniques, and flash photolysis. 2. The instantaneous rate of a reaction is the slope of the tangent ot the graph of concentration against time (expressed as a positive quantity). 3. A rate law is an expression for the reaction rate in terms of the concentrations of the species that occur in the overall chemical reaction. 4. For a rate law of the form v = k[A]a [B]b . . . , the rate constant is k, the order with respect to A is a, and the overall order is a + b + . . . . 5. An integrated rate law is an expression for the concentration of a reactant or product as a function of time (Table 22.3). 6. The half-life t1/2 of a reaction is the time it takes for the concentration of a species to fall to half its initial value. The time constant τ is the time required for the concentration of a reactant to fall to 1/e of its initial value. For a first-order reaction, t1/2 = (ln 2)/k and τ = 1/k. 7. The equilibrium constant for a reaction is equal to the ratio of the forward and reverse rate constants, K = k/k′. 8. In relaxation methods of kinetic analysis, the equilibrium position of a reaction is first shifted suddenly and then allowed to readjust the equilibrium composition characteristic of the new conditions. 9. The temperature dependence of the rate constant of a reaction typically follows the Arrhenius equation, ln k = ln A − Ea/RT. 10. The activation energy, the parameter Ea in the Arrhenius equation, is the minimum kinetic energy for reaction during a molecular encounter. The larger the activation energy, the more sensitive the rate constant is to the temperature. 11. The mechanism of reaction is the sequence of elementary steps involved in a reaction. 12. The molecularity of an elementary reaction is the number of molecules coming together to react. An elementary unimolecular reaction has first-order kinetics; an elementary bimolecular reaction has second-order kinetics. 13. The rate-determining step is the slowest step in a reaction mechanism that controls the rate of the overall reaction. 14. In the steady-state approximation, it is assumed that the concentrations of all reaction intermediates remain constant and small throughout the reaction. 15. Provided a reaction has not reached equilibrium, the products of competing reactions are controlled by kinetics, with [P2]/[P1] = k2/k1. 16. Pre-equilibrium is a state in which an intermediate is in equilibrium with the reactants and which arises when the rates of formation of the intermediate and its decay back into reactants are much faster than its rate of formation of products. 17. The kinetic isotope effect is the decrease in the rate of a chemical reaction upon replacement of one atom in a reactant by a heavier isotope. A primary kinetic isotope effect is observed when the rate-determining step requires the scission of a bond involving the isotope. A secondary kinetic isotope effect is the reduction in reaction rate even though the bond involving the isotope is not broken to form product. 18. The Lindemann–Hinshelwood mechanism and the RRKM model of ‘unimolecular’ reactions account for the first-order kinetics of gas-phase reactions. Further reading Articles and texts J. Andraos, A streamlined approach to solving simple and complex kinetic systems analytically. J. Chem. Educ. 76, 1578 (1999). C.H. Bamford, C.F. Tipper, and R.G. Compton (ed.), Comprehensive chemical kinetics. Vols. 1–38, Elsevier, Amsterdam (1969–2001). M.N. Berberan-Santos and J.M.G. Martinho, Integration of kinetic rate equations by matrix methods. J. Chem. Educ. 67, 375 (1990). J.M. Goodman, How do approximations affect the solutions to kinetic equations? J. Chem. Educ. 76, 275 (1999). 824 22 THE RATES OF CHEMICAL REACTIONS J.C. Lindon, G.E. Tranter, and J.L. Holmes (ed.), Encyclopedia of spectroscopy and spectrometry. Academic Press, San Diego (2000). S.R. Logan, Fundamentals of chemical kinetics. Longman, Harlow (1996). M.J. Pilling and P.W. Seakins, Reaction kinetics. Oxford University Press (1996). J.I. Steinfeld, J.S. Francisco, and W.L. Hase, Chemical kinetics and dynamics. Prentice Hall, Englewood Cliffs (1998). Sources of data and information NDRL/NIST solution kinetics database, NIST standard reference database 40, National Institute of Standards and Technology, Gaithersburg (1994). For the URL, see the web site for this book. NIST chemical kinetics database, NIST standard reference database 17, National Institute of Standards and Technology, Gaithersburg (1998). For the URL, see the web site for this book. Further information Further information 22.1 The RRK model of unimolecular reactions To set up the RRK model, we suppose that a molecule consists of s identical harmonic oscillators, each of which has frequency ν. In practice, of course, the vibrational modes of a molecule have different frequencies, but assuming that they are all the same is a good first approximation. Next, we suppose that the vibrations are excited to a total energy E = nhν and then set out to calculate the number of ways N in which the energy can be distributed over the oscillators. We can represent the n quanta as follows: ᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀ ᮀ . . . ᮀᮀᮀ These quanta must be put in s containers (the s oscillators), which can be represented by inserting s − 1 walls, denoted by |. One such distribution is ᮀᮀ|ᮀᮀᮀᮀ|ᮀᮀ||ᮀᮀᮀ|ᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀ|ᮀᮀᮀᮀ|||ᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀ|ᮀ ᮀᮀᮀ . . . ᮀ|ᮀᮀ The total number of arrangements of each quantum and wall (of which there are n + s −1 in all) is (n + s − 1)! where, as usual, x! = x(x − 1)! . . . 1. However the n! arrangements of the n quanta are indistinguishable, as are the (s −1)! arrangements of the s − 1 walls. Therefore, to find N we must divide (n + s − 1)! by these two factorials. It follows that N = (22.71) The distribution of the energy throughout the molecule means that it is too sparsely spread over all the modes for any particular bond to be sufficiently highly excited to undergo dissociation. If we suppose that a bond will break if it is excited to at least an energy E* = n*hν, then the number of ways in which at least this energy can be localized in one bond is N* = (22.72) To obtain this result, we isolate one critical oscillator as the one that undergoes dissociation if it has at least n* of the quanta, leaving up to n − n* quanta to be accommodated in the remaining s − 1 oscillators (and therefore with s − 2 walls in the partition in place of the s − 1 (n − n* + s − 1)! (n − n*)!(s − 1)! (n + s − 1)! n!(s − 1)! walls we used above). We suppose that the critical oscillator consists of a single level plus an array of levels like the other oscillators, and that dissociation occurs however many quanta are in this latter array of levels, from 0 upwards. For example, in a system of five oscillators (other than the critical one) we might suppose that at least 6 quanta out of the 28 available must be present in the critical oscillator, then all the following partitions will result in dissociation: ᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀ|ᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀ|ᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀ|ᮀᮀᮀᮀ||ᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀ ᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀ|ᮀᮀᮀᮀ|ᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀ|ᮀᮀᮀᮀ||ᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀ ᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀ|ᮀᮀᮀ|ᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀ|ᮀᮀᮀᮀ||ᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀ · · · (The leftmost partition is the critical oscillator.) However, these partitions are equivalent to ᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀ |ᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀ|ᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀ|ᮀᮀᮀᮀ||ᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀ ᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀ ᮀ|ᮀᮀᮀᮀ|ᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀ|ᮀᮀᮀᮀ||ᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀ ᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀ ᮀᮀ|ᮀᮀᮀ|ᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀ|ᮀᮀᮀᮀ||ᮀᮀᮀᮀᮀ · · · and we see that we have the problem of permuting 28 − 6 = 22 (in general, n − n*) quanta and 5 (in general, s − 1) walls, and therefore a total of 27 (in general, n − n* + s − 1 objects). Therefore, the calculation is exactly like the one above for N, except that we have to find the number of distinguishable permutations of n − n* quanta in s containers (and therefore s − 1 walls). The number N* is therefore obtained from eqn 22.71 by replacing n by n − n*. From the preceding discussion we conclude that the probability that one specific oscillator will have undergone sufficient excitation to dissociate is the ratio N*/N, which is P = = (22.73) Equation 22.73 is still awkward to use, even when written out in terms of its factors: P = × = (n − n* + s − 1)(n − n* + s − 2) . . . (n − n* + 1) (n + s − 1)(n + s − 2) . . . (n + 2)(n + 1) (n − n* + s − 1)(n − n* + s − 2) . . . 1 (n + s − 1)(n + s − 2) . . . 1 n(n − 1)(n − 2) . . . 1 (n − n*)(n − n* − 1) . . . 1 n!(n − n* + s − 1)! (n − n*)!(n + s − 1) N* N EXERCISES 825 However, because s − 1 is small (in the sense s − 1 << n − n*), we can approximate this expression by P ≈ = s−1 Because the energy of the excited molecule is E = nhν and the critical energy is E* = n*hν, this expression may be written D E F n − n* n A B C (n − n*)(n − n*) . . . (n − n*)s−1 factors (n)(n) . . . (n)s−1 factors P = 1 − s−1 as in eqn 22.68a. The dispersal of the energy of the collision reduces the rate constant below its simple ‘Lindemann’ form, and to obtain the observed rate constant we should multiply the latter by the probability that the energy will in fact be localized in the bond of interest, which gives eqn 22.68b. D E F E* E A B C Discussion questions 22.1 Consult literature sources and list the observed timescales during which the following processes occur: radiative decay of excited electronic states, molecular rotational motion, molecular vibrational motion, proton transfer reactions, the initial event of vision, energy transfer in photosynthesis, the initial electron transfer events in photosynthesis, the helix-to-coil transition in polypeptides, and collisions in liquids. 22.2 Write a brief report on a recent research article in which at least one of the following techniques was used to study the kinetics of a chemical reaction: stopped-flow techniques, flash photolysis, chemical quench-flow methods, freeze quench methods, temperature-jump methods, or pressure-jump methods. Your report should be similar in content and size to one of the Impact sections found throughout this text. 22.3 Describe the main features, including advantages and disadvantages, of the following experimental methods for determining the rate law of a reaction: the isolation method, the method of initial rates, and fitting data to integrated rate law expressions. 22.4 Distinguish between reaction order and molecularity. 22.5 Assess the validity of the following statement: the rate-determining step is the slowest step in a reaction mechanism. 22.6 Distinguish between a pre-equilibrium approximation and a steady-state approximation. 22.7 Distinguish between kinetic and thermodynamic control of a reaction. 22.8 Define the terms in and limit the generality of the expression ln k = ln A − Ea/RT. 22.9 Distinguish between a primary and a secondary kinetic isotope effect. Discuss how kinetic isotope effects in general can provide insight into the mechanism of a reaction. 22.10 Discuss the limitations of the generality of the expression k = kakb[A]/(kb + k′a[A]) for the effective rate constant of a unimolecular reaction A → P with the following mechanism: A + A 5 A* + A (ka, k′a), A* → P (kb). Suggest an experimental procedure that may either support or refute the mechanism. Exercises 22.1a The rate of the reaction A + 2 B → 3 C + D was reported as 1.0 mol dm−3 s−1 . State the rates of formation and consumption of the participants. 22.1b The rate of the reaction A + 3 B → C + 2 D was reported as 1.0 mol dm−3 s−1 . State the rates of formation and consumption of the participants. 22.2a The rate of formation of C in the reaction 2 A + B → 2 C + 3 D is 1.0 mol dm−3 s−1 . State the reaction rate, and the rates of formation or consumption of A, B, and D. 22.2b The rate of consumption of B in the reaction A + 3 B → C + 2 D is 1.0 mol dm−3 s−1 . State the reaction rate, and the rates of formation or consumption of A, C, and D. 22.3a The rate law for the reaction in Exercise 22.1a was found to be v = k[A][B]. What are the units of k? Express the rate law in terms of the rates of formation and consumption of (a) A, (b) C. 22.3b The rate law for the reaction in Exercise 22.1b was found to be v = k[A][B]2 . What are the units of k? Express the rate law in terms of the rates of formation and consumption of (a) A, (b) C. 22.4a The rate law for the reaction in Exercise 22.2a was reported as d[C]/dt = k[A][B][C]. Express the rate law in terms of the reaction rate; what are the units for k in each case? 22.4b The rate law for the reaction in Exercise 22.2b was reported as d[C]/dt = k[A][B][C]−1 . Express the rate law in terms of the reaction rate; what are the units for k in each case? 22.5a At 518°C, the rate of decomposition of a sample of gaseous acetaldehyde, initially at a pressure of 363 Torr, was 1.07 Torr s−1 when 5.0 per cent had reacted and 0.76 Torr s−1 when 20.0 per cent had reacted. Determine the order of the reaction. 22.5b At 400 K, the rate of decomposition of a gaseous compound initially at a pressure of 12.6 kPa, was 9.71 Pa s−1 when 10.0 per cent had reacted and 7.67 Pa s−1 when 20.0 per cent had reacted. Determine the order of the reaction. 22.6a At 518°C, the half-life for the decomposition of a sample of gaseous acetaldehyde (ethanal) initially at 363 Torr was 410 s. When the pressure was 169 Torr, the half-life was 880 s. Determine the order of the reaction. 22.6b At 400 K, the half-life for the decomposition of a sample of a gaseous compound initially at 55.5 kPa was 340 s. When the pressure was 28.9 kPa, the half-life was 178 s. Determine the order of the reaction. 22.7a The rate constant for the first-order decomposition of N2O5 in the reaction 2 N2O5(g) → 4 NO2(g) + O2(g) is k = 3.38 × 10−5 s−1 at 25°C. What is the half-life of N2O5? What will be the pressure, initially 500 Torr, at (a) 10 s, (b) 10 min after initiation of the reaction? 22.7b The rate constant for the first-order decomposition of a compound A in the reaction 2 A → P is k = 2.78 × 10−7 s−1 at 25°C. What is the half-life of A? What will be the pressure, initially 32.1 kPa, at (a) 10 s, (b) 10 min after initiation of the reaction? 826 22 THE RATES OF CHEMICAL REACTIONS 22.8a A second-order reaction of the type A + B → P was carried out in a solution that was initially 0.050 mol dm−3 in A and 0.080 mol dm−3 in B. After 1.0 h the concentration of A had fallen to 0.020 mol dm−3 . (a) Calculate the rate constant. (b) What is the half-life of the reactants? 22.8b A second-order reaction of the type A + 2 B → P was carried out in a solution that was initially 0.075 mol dm−3 in A and 0.030 mol dm−3 in B. After 1.0 h the concentration of A had fallen to 0.045 mol dm−3 . (a) Calculate the rate constant. (b) What is the half-life of the reactants? 22.9a If the rate laws are expressed with (a) concentrations in moles per decimetre cubed, (b) pressures in kilopascals, what are the units of the secondorder and third-order rate constants? 22.9b If the rate laws are expressed with (a) concentrations in molecules per metre cubed, (b) pressures in newtons per metre squared, what are the units of the second-order and third-order rate constants? 22.10a The second-order rate constant for the reaction CH3COOC2H5(aq) + OH− (aq) → CH3CO2 − (aq) + CH3CH2OH(aq) is 0.11 dm3 mol−1 s−1 . What is the concentration of ester after (a) 10 s, (b) 10 min when ethyl acetate is added to sodium hydroxide so that the initial concentrations are [NaOH] = 0.050 mol dm−3 and [CH3COOC2H5] = 0.100 mol dm−3 ? 22.10b The second-order rate constant for the reaction A + 2 B → C + D is 0.21 dm3 mol−1 s−1 . What is the concentration of C after (a) 10 s, (b) 10 min when the reactants are mixed with initial concentrations of [A] = 0.025 mol dm−3 and [B] = 0.150 mol dm−3 ? 22.11a A reaction 2 A → P has a second-order rate law with k = 3.50 × 10−4 dm3 mol−1 s−1 . Calculate the time required for the concentration of A to change from 0.260 mol dm−3 to 0.011 mol dm−3 . 22.11b A reaction 2 A → P has a third-order rate law with k = 3.50 × 10−4 dm6 mol−2 s−1 . Calculate the time required for the concentration of A to change from 0.077 mol dm−3 to 0.021 mol dm−3 . 22.12a Show that t1/2 ∝ 1/[A]n−1 for a reaction that is nth-order in A. 22.12b Deduce an expression for the time it takes for the concentration of a substance to fall to one-third its initial value in an nth-order reaction. 22.13a The pKa of NH4 + is 9.25 at 25°C. The rate constant at 25°C for the reaction of NH4 + and OH− to form aqueous NH3 is 4.0 × 1010 dm3 mol−1 s−1 . Calculate the rate constant for proton transfer to NH3. What relaxation time would be observed if a temperature jump were applied to a solution of 0.15 mol dm−3 NH3(aq) at 25°C? 22.13b The equilibrium A 5 B + C at 25°C is subjected to a temperature jump that slightly increases the concentrations of B and C. The measured relaxation time is 3.0 µs. The equilibrium constant for the system is 2.0 × 10−16 at 25°C, and the equilibrium concentrations of B and C at 25°C are both 2.0 × 10−4 mol dm−3 . Calculate the rate constants for steps (1) and (2). 22.14a The rate constant for the decomposition of a certain substance is 2.80 × 10−3 dm3 mol−1 s−1 at 30°C and 1.38 × 10−2 dm3 mol−1 s−1 at 50°C. Evaluate the Arrhenius parameters of the reaction. 22.14b The rate constant for the decomposition of a certain substance is 1.70 × 10−2 dm3 mol−1 s−1 at 24°C and 2.01 × 10−2 dm3 mol−1 s−1 at 37°C. Evaluate the Arrhenius parameters of the reaction. 22.15a The base-catalysed bromination of nitromethane-d3 in water at room temperature (298 K) proceeds 4.3 times more slowly than the bromination of the undeuterated material. Account for this difference. Use kf(C-H) = 450 N m−1 . 22.15b Predict the order of magnitude of the isotope effect on the relative rates of displacement of (a) 1 H and 3 H, (b) 16 O and 18 O. Will raising the temperature enhance the difference? Take kf(C-H) = 450 N m−1 , kf(C-O) = 1750 N m−1 . 22.16a The effective rate constant for a gaseous reaction that has a Lindemann–Hinshelwood mechanism is 2.50 × 10−4 s−1 at 1.30 kPa and 2.10 × 10−5 s−1 at 12 Pa. Calculate the rate constant for the activation step in the mechanism. 22.16b The effective rate constant for a gaseous reaction that has a Lindemann–Hinshelwood mechanism is 1.7 × 10−3 s−1 at 1.09 kPa and 2.2 × 10−4 s−1 at 25 Pa. Calculate the rate constant for the activation step in the mechanism. Problems* Numerical problems 22.1 The data below apply to the formation of urea from ammonium cyanate, NH4CNO → NH2CONH2. Initially 22.9 g of ammonium cyanate was dissolved in in enough water to prepare 1.00 dm3 of solution. Determine the order of the reaction, the rate constant, and the mass of ammonium cyanate left after 300 min. t/min 0 20.0 50.0 65.0 150 m(urea)/g 0 7.0 12.1 13.8 17.7 22.2 The data below apply to the reaction, (CH3)3CBr + H2O → (CH3)3COH + HBr. Determine the order of the reaction, the rate constant, and the molar concentration of (CH3)3CBr after 43.8 h. t/h 0 3.15 6.20 10.00 18.30 30.80 [(CH3)3CBr]/(10−2 mol dm−3 ) 10.39 8.96 7.76 6.39 3.53 2.07 22.3 The thermal decomposition of an organic nitrile produced the following data: t/(103 s) 0 2.00 4.00 6.00 8.00 10.00 12.00 ∞ [nitrile]/(mol dm−3 ) 1.10 0.86 0.67 0.52 0.41 0.32 0.25 0 Determine the order of the reaction and the rate constant. 22.4 The following data have been obtained for the decomposition of N2O5(g) at 67°C according to the reaction 2 N2O5(g) → 4 NO2(g) + O2(g). Determine the order of the reaction, the rate constant, and the half-life. It is not necessary to obtain the result graphically, you may do a calculation using estimates of the rates of change of concentration. t/min 0 1 2 3 4 5 [N2O5]/(mol dm−3 ) 1.000 0.705 0.497 0.349 0.246 0.173 22.5 A first-order decomposition reaction is observed to have the following rate constants at the indicated temperatures. Estimate the activation energy. k/(10−3 s−1 ) 2.46 45.1 576 θ/°C 0 20.0 40.0 * Problems denoted with the symbol ‡ were supplied by Charles Trapp, Carmen Giunta, and Marshall Cady. PROBLEMS 827 22.6 The gas-phase decomposition of acetic acid at 1189 K proceeds by way of two parallel reactions: (1) CH3COOH → CH4 + CO2 k1 = 3.74 s−1 (2) CH3COOH → H2C=C=O + H2O k2 = 4.65 s−1 What is the maximum percentage yield of the ketene CH2CO obtainable at this temperature? 22.7 Sucrose is readily hydrolysed to glucose and fructose in acidic solution. The hydrolysis is often monitored by measuring the angle of rotation of planepolarized light passing through the solution. From the angle of rotation the concentration of sucrose can be determined. An experiment on the hydrolysis of sucrose in 0.50 M HCl(aq) produced the following data: t/min 0 14 39 60 80 110 140 170 210 [sucrose]/(mol dm−3 ) 0.316 0.300 0.274 0.256 0.238 0.211 0.190 0.170 0.146 Determine the rate constant of the reaction and the half-life of a sucrose molecule. What is the average liftime of a sucrose molecule? 22.8 The composition of a liquid-phase reaction 2 A → B was followed by a spectrophotometric method with the following results: t/min 0 10 20 30 40 ∞ [B]/(mol dm−3 ) 0 0.089 0.153 0.200 0.230 0.312 Determine the order of the reaction and its rate constant. 22.9 The ClO radical decays rapidly by way of the reaction, 2 ClO → Cl2 + O2. The following data have been obtained: t/(10−3 s) 0.12 0.62 0.96 1.60 3.20 4.00 5.75 [ClO]/(10−6 mol dm−3 ) 8.49 8.09 7.10 5.79 5.20 4.77 3.95 Determine the rate constant of the reaction and the half-life of a ClO radical. 22.10 Cyclopropane isomerizes into propene when heated to 500°C in the gas phase. The extent of conversion for various initial pressures has been followed by gas chromatography by allowing the reaction to proceed for a time with various initial pressures: p0/Torr 200 200 400 400 600 600 t/s 100 200 100 200 100 200 p/Torr 186 173 373 347 559 520 where p0 is the initial pressure and p is the final pressure of cyclopropane. What are the order and rate constant for the reaction under these conditions? 22.11 The addition of hydrogen halides to alkenes has played a fundamental role in the investigation of organic reaction mechanisms. In one study (M.J. Haugh and D.R. Dalton, J. Amer. Chem. Soc. 97, 5674 (1975)), high pressures of hydrogen chloride (up to 25 atm) and propene (up to 5 atm) were examined over a range of temperatures and the amount of 2-chloropropane formed was determined by NMR. Show that, if the reaction A + B → P proceeds for a short time δt, the concentration of product follows [P]/[A] = k[A]m−1 [B]n δt if the reaction is mth-order in A and nth-order in B. In a series of runs the ratio of [chloropropane] to [propene] was independent of [propene] but the ratio of [chloropropane] to [HCl] for constant amounts of propene depended on [HCl]. For δt ≈ 100 h (which is short on the timescale of the reaction) the latter ratio rose from zero to 0.05, 0.03, 0.01 for p(HCl) = 10 atm, 7.5 atm, 5.0 atm, respectively. What are the orders of the reaction with respect to each reactant? 22.12 Use mathematical software or an electronic spreadsheet to examine the time dependence of [I] in the reaction mechanism A → I → P (k1, k2). You may either integrate eqn 22.39 numerically (see Appendix 2) or use eqn 22.40 directly. In all the following calculations, use [A]0 = 1 mol dm−3 and a time range of 0 to 5 s. (a) Plot [I] against t for k1 = 10 s−1 and k2 = 1 s−1 . (b) Increase the ratio k2/k1 steadily by decreasing the value of k1 and examine the plot of [I] against t at each turn. What approximation about d[I]/dt becomes increasingly valid? 22.13 Show that the following mechanism can account for the rate law of the reaction in Problem 22.11: HCl + HCl 5 (HCl)2 K1 HCl + CH3CH=CH2 5 complex K2 (HCl)2 + complex → CH3CHClCH3 + 2 HCl k (slow) What further tests could you apply to verify this mechanism? 22.14 Consider the dimerization 2 A 5 A2, with forward rate constant ka and backward rate constant kb. (a) Derive the following expression for the relaxation time in terms of the total concentration of protein, [A]tot, = [A] + 2[A2]: = k2 b + 8kakb[A]tot (b) Describe the computational procedures that lead to the determination of the rate constants ka and kb from measurements of τ for different values of [A]tot. (c) Use the data provided below and the procedure you outlined in part (b) to calculate the rate constants ka and kb, and the equilibrium constant K for formation of hydrogen-bonded dimers of 2-pyridone: [A]tot/(mol dm−3 ) 0.500 0.352 0.251 0.151 0.101 τ/ns 2.3 2.7 3.3 4.0 5.3 22.15 In the experiments described in Problems 22.11 and 22.13 an inverse temperature dependence of the reaction rate was observed, the overall rate of reaction at 70°C being roughly one-third that at 19°C. Estimate the apparent activation energy and the activation energy of the rate-determining step given that the enthalpies of the two equilibria are both of the order of −14 kJ mol−1 . 22.16 The second-order rate constants for the reaction of oxygen atoms with aromatic hydrocarbons have been measured (R. Atkinson and J.N. Pitts, J. Phys. Chem. 79, 295 (1975)). In the reaction with benzene the rate constants are 1.44 × 107 dm3 mol−1 s−1 at 300.3 K, 3.03 × 107 dm3 mol−1 s−1 at 341.2 K, and 6.9 × 107 dm3 mol−1 s−1 at 392.2 K. Find the pre-exponential factor and activation energy of the reaction. 22.17 In Problem 22.10 the isomerization of cyclopropane over a limited pressure range was examined. If the Lindemann mechanism of first-order reactions is to be tested we also need data at low pressures. These have been obtained (H.O. Pritchard, R.G. Sowden, and A.F. Trotman-Dickenson, Proc. R. Soc. A217, 563 (1953)): p/Torr 84.1 11.0 2.89 0.569 0.120 0.067 104 keff/s−1 2.98 2.23 1.54 0.857 0.392 0.303 Test the Lindemann theory with these data. 22.18‡ P.W. Seakins, M.J. Pilling, L.T. Niiranen, D. Gutman, and L.N. Krasnoperov (J. Phys. Chem. 96, 9847 (1992)) measured the forward and reverse rate constants for the gas-phase reaction C2H5(g) + HBr(g) → C2H6(g) + Br(g) and used their findings to compute thermodynamic parameters for C2H5. The reaction is bimolecular in both directions with Arrhenius parameters A = 1.0 × 109 dm3 mol−1 s−1 , Ea = −4.2 kJ mol−1 for the forward reaction and k′ = 1.4 × 1011 dm3 mol−1 s−1 , Ea = 53.3 kJ mol−1 for the reverse reaction. Compute ∆fH7 , S7 m, and ∆f G7 of C2H5 at 298 K. 22.19 Two products are formed in reactions in which there is kinetic control of the ratio of products. The activation energy for the reaction leading to Product 1 is greater than that leading to Product 2. Will the ratio of product concentrations [P1]/[P2] increase or decrease if the temperature is raised? Theoretical problems 22.20 The reaction mechanism A2 5 A + A (fast) A + B → P (slow) involves an intermediate A. Deduce the rate law for the reaction. 1 τ2 After intravenous administration of a beta blocker, the blood plasma of a patient was analysed for remaining drug and the data are shown below, where c is the drug concentration measured at a time t after the injection. t/min 30 60 120 150 240 360 480 c/(ng cm−3 ) 699 622 413 292 152 60 24 (a) Is removal of the drug a first- or second-order process? (b) Calculate the rate constant and half-life of the process. Comment. An essential aspect of drug development is the optimization of the half-life of elimination, which needs to be long enough to allow the drug to find and act on its target organ but not so long that harmful side-effects become important. 22.32 The absorption and elimination of a drug in the body may be modelled with a mechanism consisting of two consecutive reactions: A → B → C drug at site of drug dispersed eliminated administration in blood drug where the rate constants of absorption (A → B) and elimination are, respectively, k1 and k2. (a) Consider a case in which absorption is so fast that it may be regarded as instantaneous so that a dose of A at an initial concentration [A]0 immediately leads to a drug concentration in blood of [B]0. Also, assume that elimination follows first-order kinetics. Show that, after the administration of n equal doses separated by a time interval τ, the peak concentration of drug B in the blood, [P]n, rises beyond the value of [B]0 and eventually reaches a constant, maximum peak value given by [P]∞ = [B]0(1 − e−k2τ )−1 where [P]n is the (peak) concentration of B immediately after administration of the nth dose and [P]∞ is the value at very large n. Also, write a mathematical expression for the residual concentration of B, [R]n, which we define to be the concentration of drug B immediately before the administration of the (n + 1)th dose. [R]n is always smaller than [P]n on account of drug elimination during the period τ between drug administrations. Show that [P]∞ – [R]∞ = [B]0. (b) Consider a drug for which k2 = 0.0289 h−1 . (i) Calculate the value of τ required to achieve [P]∞/[B]0 = 10. Prepare a graph that plots both [P]n/[B]0 and [R]n/[B]0 against n. (ii) How many doses must be administered to achieve a [P]n value that is 75 per cent of the maximum value? What time has passed during the administration of these doses? (iii) What actions can be taken to reduce the variation [P]∞ – [R]∞ while maintaining the same value of [P]∞? (c) Now consider the administration of a single dose [A]0 for which absorption follows first-order kinetics and elimination follows zero-order kinetics. Show that with the initial concentration [B]0 = 0, the concentration of drug in the blood is given by [B] = [A]0(1 − e−k1t ) − k2t Plot [B]/[A]0 against t for the case k1 = 10 h−1 , k2 = 4.0 × 10−3 mmol dm−3 h−1 , and [A]0 = 0.1 mmol dm−3 . Comment on the shape of the curve. (d) Using the model from part (c), set d[B]/dt = 0 and show that the maximum value of [B] occurs at the time tmax = ln . Also, show that the maximum concentration of drug in blood is given by [B]max = [A]0 − k2/k1 − k2tmax. 22.33 Consider a mechanism for the helix–coil transition in which nucleation occurs in the middle of the chain: hhhh . . . 5 hchh . . . hchh . . . 5 cccc . . . We saw in Impact I22.1 that this type of nucleation is relatively slow, so neither step may be rate-determining. (a) Set up the rate equations for this mechanism. (b) Apply the steady-state approximation and show that, under these circumstances, the mechanism is equivalent to hhhh . . . ⇔ cccc . . . . D E F k1[A]0 k2 A B C 1 k1 828 22 THE RATES OF CHEMICAL REACTIONS 22.21 The equilibrium A 5 B is first-order in both directions. Derive an expression for the concentration of A as a function of time when the initial molar concentrations of A and B are [A]0 and [B]0. What is the final composition of the system? 22.22 Derive an integrated expression for a second-order rate law v = k[A][B] for a reaction of stoichiometry 2 A + 3 B → P. 22.23 Derive the integrated form of a third-order rate law v = k[A]2 [B] in which the stoichiometry is 2 A + B → P and the reactants are initially present in (a) their stoichiometric proportions, (b) with B present initially in twice the amount. 22.24 Set up the rate equations for the reaction mechanism: A B C Show that the mechanism is equivalent to A C under specified circumstances. 22.25 Show that the ratio t1/2/t3/4, where t1/2 is the half-life and t3/4 is the time for the concentration of A to decrease to 3 –4 of its initial value (implying that t3/4 < t1/2) can be written as a function of n alone, and can therefore be used as a rapid assessment of the order of a reaction. 22.26 Derive an equation for the steady-state rate of the sequence of reactions A 5 B 5 C 5 D, with [A] maintained at a fixed value and the product D removed as soon as it is formed. 22.27‡ For a certain second-order reaction A + B → Products, the rate of reaction, v, may be written v = = k([A]0 − x)([B]0 + x) where x is the decrease in concentration of A or B as a result of reaction. Find an expression for the maximum rate and the conditions under which it applies. Draw a graph of v against x, and noting that v and x cannot be negative, identify the portion of the curve that corresponds to reality. 22.28 Consider the dimerization A ⇔ A2 with forward rate constant ka and backward rate constant kb. Show that the relaxation time is: τ = Applications: to archaeology, biochemistry, and environmental science 22.29 The half-life for the (first-order) radioactive decay of 14 C is 5730 y (it emits β rays with an energy of 0.16 MeV). An archaeological sample contained wood that had only 72 per cent of the 14 C found in living trees. What is its age? 22.30 One of the hazards of nuclear explosions is the generation of 90 Sr and its subsequent incorporation in place of calcium in bones. This nuclide emits β rays of energy 0.55 MeV, and has a half-life of 28.1 y. Suppose 1.00 µg was absorbed by a newly born child. How much will remain after (a) 18 y, (b) 70 y if none is lost metabolically? 22.31 Pharmacokinetics is the study of the rates of absorption and elimination of drugs by organisms. In most cases, elimination is slower than absorption and is a more important determinant of availability of a drug for binding to its target. A drug can be eliminated by many mechanisms, such as metabolism in the liver, intestine, or kidney followed by excretion of breakdown products through urine or faeces. As an example of pharmacokinetic analysis, consider the elimination of beta adrenergic blocking agents (beta blockers), drugs used in the treatment of hypertension. 1 kb + 4ka[A]eq dx dt PROBLEMS 829 (c) Use your knowledge of experimental techniques and your results from parts (a) and (b) to support or refute the following statement: It is very difficult to obtain experimental evidence for intermediates in protein folding by performing simple rate measurements and one must resort to special flow, relaxation, or trapping techniques to detect intermediates directly. 22.34 Propose a set of experiments in which analysis of the line-shapes of NMR transitions (Section 15.7) can be used to monitor fast events in protein folding and unfolding. What are the disadvantages and disadvantages of this NMR method over methods that use electronic and vibrational spectroscopy? 22.35 Consider the following mechanism for renaturation of a double helix from its strands A and B: A + B 5 unstable helix (fast) Unstable helix → stable double helix (slow) Derive the rate equation for the formation of the double helix and express the rate constant of the renaturation reaction in terms of the rate constants of the individual steps. 22.36‡ Prebiotic reactions are reactions that might have occurred under the conditions prevalent on the Earth before the first living creatures emerged and which can lead to analogues of molecules necessary for life as we now know it. To qualify, a reaction must proceed with favourable rates and equilibria. M.P. Robertson and S.I. Miller (Science 268, 702(1995)) have studied the prebiotic synthesis of 5-substituted uracils, among them 5-hydroxymethyluracil (HMU). Amino acid analogues can be formed from HMU under prebiotic conditions by reaction with various nucleophiles, such as H2S, HCN, indole, imidazole, etc. For the synthesis of HMU (the uracil analogue of serine) from uracil and formaldehyde (HCHO), the rate of addition is given by log {k/(dm3 mol−1 s−1 )} = 11.75 −5488/(T/K) (at pH = 7), and log K = −1.36 + 1794/(T/K). For this reaction, calculate the rates and equilibrium constants over a range of temperatures corresponding to possible prebiotic conditions, such as 0–50°C, and plot them against temperature. Also, calculate the activation energy and the standard reaction Gibbs energy and enthalpy at 25°C. Prebiotic conditions are not likely to be standard conditions. Speculate about how the actual values of the reaction Gibbs energy and enthalpy might differ from the standard values. Do you expect that the reaction would still be favourable? 22.37‡ Methane is a by-product of a number of natural processes (such as digestion of cellulose in ruminant animals, anaerobic decomposition of organic waste matter) and industrial processes (such as food production and fossil fuel use). Reaction with the hydroxyl radical OH is the main path by which CH4 is removed from the lower atmosphere. T. Gierczak, R.K. Talukdar, S.C. Herndon, G.L. Vaghjiani, and A.R. Ravishankara (J. Phys. Chem. A 101, 3125 (1997)) measured the rate constants for the elementary bimolecular gas-phase reaction of methane with the hydroxyl radical over a range of temperatures of importance to atmospheric chemistry. Deduce the Arrhenius parameters A and Ea from the following measurements: T/K 295 223 218 213 206 200 195 k/(106 dm3 mol−1 s−1 ) 3.55 0.494 0.452 0.379 0.295 0.241 0.217 22.38‡ As we saw in Problem 22.37, reaction with the hydroxyl radical OH is the main path by which CH4, a by-product of many natural and industrial processes, is removed from the lower atmosphere. T. Gierczak, R.K. Talukdar, S.C. Herndon, G.L. Vaghjiani, and A.R. Ravishankara (J. Phys. Chem. A 101, 3125 (1997)) measured the rate constants for the bimolecular gas-phase reaction CH4(g) + OH(g) → CH3(g) + H2O(g) and found A = 1.13 × 109 dm3 mol−1 s−1 and Ea = 14.1 kJ mol−1 for the Arrhenius parameters. (a) Estimate the rate of consumption of CH4. Take the average OH concentration to be 1.5 × 10−21 mol dm−3 , that of CH4 to be 4.0 × 10−8 mol dm−3 , and the temperature to be −10°C. (b) Estimate the global annual mass of CH4 consumed by this reaction (which is slightly less than the amount introduced to the atmosphere) given an effective volume for the Earth’s lower atmosphere of 4 × 1021 dm3 . 22.39‡ T. Gierczak, R.K. Talukdar, S.C. Herndon, G.L. Vaghjiani, and A.R. Ravishankara (J. Phys. Chem. A 101, 3125 (1997)) measured the rate constants for the bimolecular gas-phase reaction of methane with the hydroxyl radical in several isotopic variations. From their data, the following Arrhenius parameters can be obtained: A/(dm3 mol−1 s−1 ) Ea/(kJ mol−1 ) CH4 + OH → CH3 + H2O 1.13 × 109 14.1 CD4 + OH → CD3 + DOH 6.0 × 108 17.5 CH4 + OD → CH3 + DOH 1.01 × 109 13.6 Compute the rate constants at 298 K, and interpret the kinetic isotope effects. 22.40‡ The oxidation of HSO3 − by O2 in aqueous solution is a reaction of importance to the processes of acid rain formation and flue gas desulfurization. R.E. Connick, Y.-X. Zhang, S. Lee, R. Adamic, and P. Chieng (Inorg. Chem. 34, 4543 (1995)) report that the reaction 2 HSO3 − + O2 → 2 SO4 2− + 2 H+ follows the rate law v = k[HSO3 − ]2 [H+ ]2 . Given a pH of 5.6 and an oxygen molar concentration of 2.4 × 10−4 mol dm−3 (both presumed constant), an initial HSO3 − molar concentration of 5 × 10−5 mol dm−3 , and a rate constant of 3.6 × 106 dm9 mol−3 s−1 , what is the initial rate of reaction? How long would it take for HSO3 − to reach half its initial concentration? The kinetics of complex reactions This chapter extends the material introduced in Chapter 22 by showing how to deal with complex reaction mechanisms. First, we consider chain reactions and see that either complicated or simple rate laws can be obtained, depending on the conditions. Under certain circumstances, a chain reaction can become explosive, and we see some of the reasons for this behaviour. An important application of these more complicated techniques is to the kinetics of polymerization reactions. There are two major classes of polymerization process and the average molar mass of the product varies with time in distinctive ways. Second, we describe homogeneous catalysis and apply the associated concepts to enzyme-catalysed reactions. Finally, we describe the principles of photochemistry and apply them to problems in environmental science, biochemistry, and medicine. Many reactions take place by mechanisms that involve several elementary steps. Some take place at a useful rate only after absorption of light or if a catalyst is present. In this chapter we see how to develop the ideas introduced in Chapter 22 to deal with these special kinds of reactions. Chain reactions Many gas-phase reactions and liquid-phase polymerization reactions are chain reactions. In a chain reaction, a reaction intermediate produced in one step generates an intermediate in a subsequent step, then that intermediate generates another intermediate, and so on. The intermediates in a chain reaction are called chain carriers. In aradicalchainreactionthechaincarriersareradicals(specieswithunpairedelectrons). Ions may also act as chain carriers. In nuclear fission the chain carriers are neutrons. 23.1 The rate laws of chain reactions A chain reaction can have a simple rate law. As a first example, consider the pyrolysis, or thermal decomposition in the absence of air, of acetaldehyde (ethanal, CH3CHO), which is found to be three-halves order in CH3CHO: CH3CHO(g) → CH4(g) + CO(g) v = k[CH3CHO]3/2 (23.1) Some ethane is also detected. The Rice–Herzfeld mechanism for this reaction is as follows (the dot signifies an unpaired electron and marks a radical): Initiation: CH3CHO → ·CH3 + ·CHO v = ki[CH3CHO] Propagation: CH3CHO + ·CH3 → CH3CO· + CH4 v = kp[CH3CHO][·CH3] Propagation: CH3CO· → ·CH3 + CO v = k′p[CH3CO·] Termination: ·CH3 + ·CH3 → CH3CH3 v = kt[·CH3]2 Chain reactions 23.1 The rate laws of chain reactions 23.2 Explosions Polymerization kinetics 23.3 Stepwise polymerization 23.4 Chain polymerization Homogeneous catalysis 23.5 Features of homogeneous catalysis 23.6 Enzymes Photochemistry 23.7 Kinetics of photophysical and photochemical processes I23.1 Impact on environmental science: The chemistry of stratospheric ozone I23.2 Impact on biochemistry: Harvesting of light during plant photosynthesis 23.8 Complex photochemical processes I23.3 Impact on medicine: Photodynamic therapy Checklist of key ideas Further reading Further information 23.1: The Förster theory of resonance energy transfer Discussion questions Exercises Problems 23 23.1 THE RATE LAWS OF CHAIN REACTIONS 831 Thechaincarriers·CH3 and·CHOareformedinitiallyintheinitiationstep.Tosimplify the treatment, we shall ignore the subsequent reactions of ·CHO, except to note that they give rise to the formation of CO and of the by-product H2. The chain carrier ·CH3 attacks other reactant molecules in the propagation steps, and each attack gives rise to a new carrier. Radicals combine and end the chain in the termination step. To test the proposed mechanism we need to show that it leads to the observed rate law. According to the steady-state approximation (Section 22.7b), the net rate of change of the intermediates (·CH3 and CH3CO·) may be set equal to zero: = ki[CH3CHO] − kp[·CH3][CH3CHO] + k′p[CH3CO·] − 2kt[·CH3]2 = 0 = kp[·CH3][CH3CHO] − k′p[CH3CO·] = 0 The sum of the two equations is ki[CH3CHO] − 2kt[·CH3]2 = 0 which shows that the steady-state approximation also implies that the rate of chain initiation is equal to the rate of chain termination. The steady-state concentration of ·CH3 radicals is [·CH3] = 1/2 [CH3CHO]1/2 (23.2) It follows that the rate of formation of CH4 is = kp[·CH3][CH3CHO] = kp 1/2 [CH3CHO]3/2 (23.3) which is in agreement with the three-halves order observed experimentally (eqn 23.1). However, this mechanism does not accommodate the formation of various known reaction by-products, such as propanone (CH3COCH3) and propanal (CH3CH2CHO). In many cases, a chain reaction leads to a complicated rate law. An example is the hydrogen–bromine reaction: H2(g) + Br2(g) → 2 HBr(g) = (23.4) The following mechanism has been proposed to account for this rate law (Fig. 23.1): Initiation: Br2 + M → Br· + Br· + M v = ki[Br2][M] where M is either Br2 or H2. This step is an example of a thermolysis, a reaction initiated by heat, which stimulates vigorous intermolecular collisions. Propagation: Br· + H2 → HBr + H· v = kp[Br·][H2] H· + Br2 → HBr + Br· v = k′p[H·][Br2] Retardation: H· + HBr → H2 + Br· v = kr[H·][HBr] Termination: Br· + Br· + M → Br2 + M* v = kt[Br·]2 [M] A retardation step reduces the net rate of formation of product. In this case, the chain carrier H· attacks a molecule of HBr, the product. In the termination step, the third body M removes the energy of recombination. Other possible termination steps include the recombination of H atoms to form H2 and combination of H and Br atoms. However, it turns out that only Br atom recombination is important because Br atoms propagate the chain more slowly and thus live longer than H atoms. The net rate of formation of the product HBr is k[H2][Br2]3/2 [Br2] + k′[HBr] d[HBr] dt D F ki 2kt A C d[CH4] dt D F ki 2kt A C d[CH3CO·] dt d[·CH3] dt Initiation Propagation Propagation Termination HBr Br2 Br2 H2 Br2 Br H HBr Fig. 23.1 A schematic representation of the mechanism of the reaction between hydrogen and bromine. Note how the reactants and products are shown as arms to the circle, but the intermediates (H and Br) occur only on the circle. Similar diagrams are used to depict the action of catalysts. 832 23 THE KINETICS OF COMPLEX REACTIONS 1 10 100 [HBr]/2[H]20 k t[H ]2 0 1 0 0 201 2– /21 Fig. 23.2 The numerical integration of the HBr rate law, Example 23.1, can be used to explore how the concentration of HBr changes with time. These runs began with stoichiometric proportions of H2 and Br2; the curves are labelled with the value of 2k′ − 1. Exploration Use mathematical software or the interactive applets found in the Living graphs section of the text’s web site to plot the concentrations of the radicals H· and Br· against time. Find a combination of rate constants that results in steady states for these intermediates. = kp[Br·][H2] + k′p[H·][Br2] − kr[H·][HBr] We can now either analyse the rate equations numerically (see Appendix 2 and Further reading) or look for approximate solutions and see if they agree with the empirical rate law. The following example illustrates the latter approach. Example 23.1 Deriving the rate equation of a chain reaction DerivetheratelawfortheformationofHBraccordingtothemechanismgivenabove. Method Make the steady-state approximation for the concentrations of any intermediates (H· and Br· in the present case) by setting the net rates of change of their concentrations equal to zero. Solve the resulting equations for the concentrations of the intermediates, and then use the resulting expressions in the equation for the net rate of formation of HBr. Answer The net rates of formation of the two intermediates are = kp[Br·][H2] − k′p[H·][Br2] − kr[H·][HBr] = 0 = 2ki[Br2][M] − kp[Br·][H2] + k′p[H·][Br2] + kr[H·][HBr] − 2kt[Br·]2 [M] = 0 The steady-state concentrations of the intermediates are obtained by solving these two simultaneous equations and are [Br·] = 1/2 [Br2]1/2 [H·] = Note that [M] has cancelled. When we substitute these concentrations into the expression for d[HBr]/dt, we obtain = This equation has the same form as the empirical rate law (eqn 23.4), so the two empirical rate constants can be identified as k = 2kp 1/2 k′ = The rate law shows that the reaction slows down as HBr forms, or as the [HBr]/ [Br2] ratio increases. This effect occurs because Br2 molecules compete with HBr molecules for H· atoms, with the propagation step H· + Br2 → HBr + Br· yielding product (HBr) and the retardation step H· + HBr → H2 + Br· converting HBr back into reactant (H2). Numerical integration of the rate law with mathematical software shows the predicted time dependence of the concentration of HBr for this mechanism (Fig. 23.2). Self-test 23.1 Deduce the rate law for the production of HBr when the initiation step is the photolysis, or light-induced decomposition, of Br2 into two bromine atoms, Br·. Let the photolysis rate be v = Iabs, where Iabs is the intensity of absorbed radiation. [See eqn 23.39 below] kr k′p D F ki kt A C 2kp(ki/kt)1/2 [H2][Br2]3/2 [Br2] + (kr/k′p)[HBr] d[HBr] dt kp(ki/kt)1/2 [H2][Br2]1/2 k′p[Br2] + kr[HBr] D F ki kt A C d[Br·] dt d[H·] dt d[HBr] dt 23.2 EXPLOSIONS 833 600 700 800 900 1000Second explosion limit First explosion limit Chain-branching explosion 6 5 4 3 2 log(/Pa)p T/K Steady reaction Third explosion limit Thermal explosion Fig. 23.3 The explosion limits of the H2 + O2 reaction. In the explosive regions the reaction proceeds explosively when heated homogeneously. 23.2 Explosions A thermal explosion is a very rapid reaction arising from a rapid increase of reaction rate with increasing temperature. The temperature of the system rises if the energy released by an exothermic reaction cannot escape, and the reaction goes faster. The acceleration of the rate results in an even faster rise of temperature, so the reaction becomes catastrophically fast. A chain-branching explosion occurs when the number of chain centres grows exponentially. An example of both types of explosion is the reaction between hydrogen and oxygen: 2 H2(g) + O2(g) → 2 H2O(g) Although the net reaction is very simple, the mechanism is very complex and has not yet been fully elucidated. A chain reaction is involved, and the chain carriers include H·, ·O·, and ·OH. Some steps involving H· are: Initiation: H2 → H· + H· v = constant (vinit) Propagation: H2 + ·OH → ·H + H2O v = kp[H2][·OH] Branching: ·O2· + ·H → ·O· + ·OH v = kb[·O2·][H·] ·O· + H2 → ·OH + ·H v = k′b[·O·][H2] Termination: H· + wall → 1 –2 H2 v = kt[H·] H· + O2 + M → HO2· + M* v = k′t[H·][O2][M] A branching step is an elementary reaction that produces more than one chain carrier. Recall that an O atom, with the ground-state configuration [He]2s2 2p4 , has two unpaired electrons. The same is true of an O2 molecule, with 12 valence electrons and a ground-state configuration 1σg 2 1σu 2 2σg 2 1πu 4 1πg 2 . The occurrence of an explosion depends on the temperature and pressure of the system, and the explosion regions for the reaction, the conditions under which explosion occurs, are shown in Fig. 23.3. At very low pressures the system is outside the explosion region and the mixture reacts smoothly. At these pressures the chain carriers produced in the branching steps can reach the walls of the container where they combine. Increasing the pressure along a vertical line in the illustration takes the system through the first explosion limit (provided the temperature is greater than about 730 K). The chain carriers react before reaching the walls and the branching reactions are explosively efficient. The reaction is smooth when the pressure is above the second explosion limit. The concentration of third-body M molecules is then so high compared to the concentrations of chain carriers that the combination of H· atoms with O2 molecules to form relatively unreactive HO2·molecules becomes faster than the branching reaction between H· atoms and O2 molecules. These long-lived HO2· molecules then diffuse to the walls and are removed there, in what amounts to another termination step. When the pressure is increased to above the third explosion limit, diffusion of HO2· molecules to the walls becomes so slow that they can react with H2 molecules (now at very high concentrations) to regenerate H atoms and H2O2 molecules. Example 23.2 Examining the explosion behaviour of a chain reaction For the reaction of hydrogen and oxygen described above, show that an explosion occurs when the rate of chain branching exceeds that of chain termination. Method Identify the onset of explosion with the rapid increase in the concentration of radicals, and for simplicity identify that concentration with the concentration of 834 23 THE KINETICS OF COMPLEX REACTIONS 0 2 4 6 8 Radicalconcentration,[X]Dk/vinit 0 21 Time, | |Dk t (a) (b) Fig. 23.4 The concentration of radicals in the fuel-rich regime of the hydrogen–oxygen reaction (a) under steady combustion conditions, (b) in the explosive region. For this graph, ∆k = kbranch − kterm. Exploration Using mathematical software, an electronic spreadsheet, or the interactive applets found in the Living graphs section of the text’s web site, explore the effect of changing the parameter ∆k = kbranch − kterm on the shapes of the curves in Figs. 23.4a and 23.4b. H· atoms, which probably outnumber the highly reactive ·OH and ·O· radicals. Set up the corresponding rate laws for the reaction intermediates and then apply the steady-state approximation. Answer The rate of formation of radicals, vrad, is identified with d[H·]/dt; therefore we write vrad = vinit + kp[·OH][H2] − kb[H·][O2] + kb′[·O·][H2] − kt[H·] − k′t[H·][O2][M] Applying the steady-state approximation to ·OH and ·O· gives = −kp[·OH][H2] + kb[H·][O2] + kb′[·O·][H2] = 0 = kb[H·][O2] − kb′[·O·][H2] = 0 The solutions of these two algebraic equations are [·O·] = [·OH] = The rate of formation of radicals is therefore vrad = vinit + (2kb[O2] − kt − k′t[O2][M])[H·] We write kbranch = 2kb[O2], a measure of the rate of the more important chainbranching step, and kterm = kt + k′t[O2][M], a measure of the rate of chain termination. Then, = vinit + (kbranch − kterm)[H·] There are two solutions. At low O2 concentrations, termination dominates branching, so kterm > kbranch. Then, [H·] = (1 − e−(kterm−kbranch)t ) As can be seen from Fig. 23.4a, in this regime there is steady combustion of hydrogen. At high O2 concentrations, branching dominates termination, or kbranch > kterm. Then, [H·] = (e(kbranch−kterm)t − 1) There is now an explosive increase in the concentration of radicals (Fig. 23.4b). Although the steady-state approximation does not hold under explosive conditions, the calculation at least gives an indication of the basis for the transition from smooth combustion to explosion. Self-test 23.2 Calculate the variation in radical composition when the rates of branching and termination are equal. [[H·] = vinitt] Not all explosions are due to chain reactions. Solid-state explosions, such as the explosion of ammonium nitrate or TNT (2,4,6-trinitrotoluene), for instance, are simply decompositions that occur very rapidly with the production of large amounts of gas phase molecules. vinit kbranch − kterm vinit kterm − kbranch d[H·] dt 2kb[H·][O2] kp[H2] kb[H·][O2] kb′[H2] d[·O·] dt d[·OH] dt 23.3 STEPWISE POLYMERIZATION 835 Polymerization kinetics In stepwise polymerization any two monomers present in the reaction mixture can link together at any time and growth of the polymer is not confined to chains that are already forming (Fig. 23.5). As a result, monomers are removed early in the reaction and, as we shall see, the average molar mass of the product grows with time. In chain polymerization an activated monomer, M, attacks another monomer, links to it, then that unit attacks another monomer, and so on. The monomer is used up as it becomes linked to the growing chains (Fig. 23.6). High polymers are formed rapidly and only the yield, not the average molar mass, of the polymer is increased by allowing long reaction times. 23.3 Stepwise polymerization Stepwise polymerization commonly proceeds by a condensation reaction, in which a small molecule (typically H2O) is eliminated in each step. Stepwise polymerization is the mechanism of production of polyamides, as in the formation of nylon-66: H2N(CH2)6NH2 + HOOC(CH2)4COOH → H2N(CH2)6NHCO(CH2)4COOH + H2O → H-[NH(CH2)6NHCO(CH2)4CO]n-OH (a) (b) (c) (c) (a) (b) (c) Fig. 23.5 In stepwise polymerization, growth can start at any pair of monomers, and so new chains begin to form throughout the reaction. Fig. 23.6 The process of chain polymerization. Chains grow as each chain acquires additional monomers. 836 23 THE KINETICS OF COMPLEX REACTIONS Polyesters and polyurethanes are formed similarly (the latter without elimination). A polyester, for example, can be regarded as the outcome of the stepwise condensation of a hydroxyacid HO-M-COOH. We shall consider the formation of a polyester from such a monomer, and measure its progress in terms of the concentration of the -COOH groups in the sample (which we denote A), for these groups gradually disappear as the condensation proceeds. Because the condensation reaction can occur between molecules containing any number of monomer units, chains of many different lengths can grow in the reaction mixture. In the absence of a catalyst, we can expect the condensation to be overall secondorder in the concentration of the -OH and -COOH (or A) groups, and write = −k[OH][A] (23.5a) However, because there is one -OH group for each -COOH group, this equation is the same as = −k[A]2 (23.5b) If we assume that the rate constant for the condensation is independent of the chain length, then k remains constant throughout the reaction. The solution of this rate law is given by eqn 22.15, and is [A] = (23.6) The fraction, p, of -COOH groups that have condensed at time t is, after application of eqn 23.6: p = = (23.7) Next, we calculate the degree of polymerization, which is defined as the average number of monomer residues per polymer molecule. This quantity is the ratio of the initial concentration of A, [A]0, to the concentration of end groups, [A], at the time of interest, because there is one -A group per polymer molecule. For example, if there were initially 1000 A groups and there are now only 10, each polymer must be 100 units long on average. Because we can express [A] in terms of p (eqn 23.7), the average number of monomers per polymer molecule, , is = = (23.8a) This result is illustrated in Fig. 23.7. When we express p in terms of the rate constant k (eqn 23.7), we find = 1 + kt[A]0 (23.8b) The average length grows linearly with time. Therefore, the longer a stepwise polymerization proceeds, the higher the average molar mass of the product. 23.4 Chain polymerization Chain polymerization occurs by addition of monomers to a growing polymer, often by a radical chain process. It results in the rapid growth of an individual polymer 1 1 − p [A]0 [A] kt[A]0 1 + kt[A]0 [A]0 − [A] [A]0 [A]0 1 + kt[A]0 d[A] dt d[A] dt 0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1 Fraction condensed, p 0 5 10 15 20 25 Averagechainlength,n Fig. 23.7 The average chain length of a polymer as a function of the fraction of reacted monomers, p. Note that p must be very close to 1 for the chains to be long. Exploration Plot the variation of p with time for a range of k values of your choosing (take [A]0 = 1.0 mol dm−3 ). 23.4 CHAIN POLYMERIZATION 837 chain for each activated monomer. Examples include the addition polymerizations of ethene, methyl methacrylate, and styrene, as in -CH2CHX· + CH2=CHX → -CH2CHXCH2CHX· and subsequent reactions. The central feature of the kinetic analysis (which is summarized in the Justification below) is that the rate of polymerization is proportional to the square root of the initiator concentration: v = k[I]1/2 [M] (23.9) Justification 23.1 The rate of chain polymerization There are three basic types of reaction step in a chain polymerization process: (a) Initiation: I → R· + R· vi = ki[I] M + R· → ·M1 (fast) where I is the initiator, R· the radical I forms, and ·M1 is a monomer radical. We have shown a reaction in which a radical is produced, but in some polymerizations the initiation step leads to the formation of an ionic chain carrier. The ratedetermining step is the formation of the radicals R· by homolysis of the initiator, so the rate of initiation is equal to the vi given above. (b) Propagation: M + ·M1 → ·M2 M + ·M2 → ·M3 Ӈ M + ·Mn−1 → ·Mn vp = kp[M][·M] If we assume that the rate of propagation is independent of chain size for sufficiently large chains, then we can use only the equation given above to describe the propagation process. Consequently, for sufficiently large chains, the rate of propagation is equal to the overall rate of polymerization. Because this chain of reactions propagates quickly, the rate at which the total concentration of radicals grows is equal to the rate of the rate-determining initiation step. It follows that production = 2fki[I] (23.10) where f is the fraction of radicals R· that successfully initiate a chain. (c) Termination: ·Mn + ·Mm → Mn+m (mutual termination) ·Mn + ·Mm → Mn + Mm (disproportionation) M + ·Mn → ·M + Mn (chain transfer) In mutual termination two growing radical chains combine. In termination by disproportionation a hydrogen atom transfers from one chain to another, corresponding to the oxidation of the donor and the reduction of the acceptor. In chain transfer, a new chain initiates at the expense of the one currently growing. Here we suppose that only mutual termination occurs. If we assume that the rate of termination is independent of the length of the chain, the rate law for termination is vt = kt[·M]2 D E F d[·M] dt A B C 838 23 THE KINETICS OF COMPLEX REACTIONS and the rate of change of radical concentration by this process is depletion = −2kt[·M]2 The steady-state approximation gives: = 2fki[I] − 2kt[·M]2 = 0 The steady-state concentration of radical chains is therefore [·M] = 1/2 [I]1/2 (23.11) Because the rate of propagation of the chains is the negative of the rate at which the monomer is consumed, we can write vP = −d[M]/dt and vP = kP[·M][M] = kp 1/2 [I]1/2 [M] (23.12) This rate is also the rate of polymerization, which has the form of eqn 23.9. The kinetic chain length, ν, is the ratio of the number of monomer units consumed per activated centre produced in the initiation step: ν = (23.13) The kinetic chain length can be expressed in terms of the rate expressions in Justification 23.1. To do so, we recognize that monomers are consumed at the rate that chains propagate. Then, ν = By making the steady-state approximation, we set the rate of production of radicals equal to the termination rate. Therefore, we can write the expression for the kinetic chain length as ν = = When we substitute the steady-state expression, eqn 23.11, for the radical concentration, we obtain ν = k[M][I]−1/2 k = 1 –2kp(fkikt)−1/2 (23.14) Consider a polymer produced by a chain mechanism with mutual termination. In this case, the average number of monomers in a polymer molecule, , produced by the reaction is the sum of the numbers in the two combining polymer chains. The average number of units in each chain is ν. Therefore, = 2ν = 2k[M][I]−1/2 (23.15) with k given in eqn 23.14. We see that, the slower the initiation of the chain (the smaller the initiator concentration and the smaller the initiation rate constant), the greater the kinetic chain length, and therefore the higher the average molar mass of the polymer. Some of the consequences of molar mass for polymers were explored in Chapter 19: now we have seen how we can exercise kinetic control over them. kp[M] 2kt[·M] kp[·M][M] 2kt[M·]2 rate of propagation of chains rate of production of radicals number of monomer units consumed number of activated centres produced D E F fki kt A B C D E F fki kt A B C d[·M] dt D E F d[·M] dt A B C 23.5 FEATURES OF HOMOGENEOUS CATALYSIS 839 Homogeneous catalysis A catalyst is a substance that accelerates a reaction but undergoes no net chemical change. The catalyst lowers the activation energy of the reaction by providing an alternative path that avoids the slow, rate-determining step of the uncatalysed reaction (Fig. 23.8). Catalysts can be very effective; for instance, the activation energy for the decomposition of hydrogen peroxide in solution is 76 kJ mol−1 , and the reaction is slow at room temperature. When a little iodide ion is added, the activation energy falls to 57 kJ mol−1 and the rate constant increases by a factor of 2000. Enzymes, which are biological catalysts, are very specific and can have a dramatic effect on the reactions they control. For example, the enzyme catalase reduces the activation energy for the decomposition of hydrogen peroxide to 8 kJ mol−1 , corresponding to an acceleration of the reaction by a factor of 1015 at 298 K. A homogeneous catalyst is a catalyst in the same phase as the reaction mixture. For example, the decomposition of hydrogen peroxide in aqueous solution is catalysed by bromide ion or catalase (Sections 23.5 and 23.6). A heterogeneous catalyst is a catalyst in a different phase from the reaction mixture. For example, the hydrogenation of ethene to ethane, a gas-phase reaction, is accelerated in the presence of a solid catalyst such as palladium, platinum, or nickel. The metal provides a surface upon which the reactants bind; this binding facilitates encounters between reactants and increases the rate of the reaction. We examine heterogeneous catalysis in Chapter 25 and consider only homogeneous catalysis here. 23.5 Features of homogeneous catalysis We can obtain some idea of the mode of action of homogeneous catalysts by examining the kinetics of the bromide-catalysed decomposition of hydrogen peroxide: 2 H2O2(aq) → 2 H2O(l) + O2(g) The reaction is believed to proceed through the following pre-equilibrium: H3O+ + H2O2 5 H3O2 + + H2O K = H3O2 + + Br− → HOBr + H2O v = k[H3O2 + ][Br− ] HOBr + H2O2 → H3O+ + O2 + Br− (fast) where we have set the activity of H2O in the equilibrium constant equal to 1 and assumed that the thermodynamic properties of the other substances are ideal. The second step is rate-determining. Therefore, we can obtain the rate law of the overall reaction by setting the overall rate equal to the rate of the second step and using the equilibrium constant to express the concentration of H3O2 + in terms of the reactants. The result is = keff[H2O2][H3O+ ][Br− ] with keff = kK, in agreement with the observed dependence of the rate on the Br− concentration and the pH of the solution. The observed activation energy is that of the effective rate constant kK. In acid catalysis the crucial step is the transfer of a proton to the substrate: X + HA → HX+ + A− HX+ → products d[O2] dt [H3O2 + ] [H2O2][H3O+ ] Ea(uncatalysed) Reactants Products Potentialenergy Reaction coordinate Ea(catalysed) Fig. 23.8 A catalyst provides a different path with a lower activation energy. The result is an increase in the rate of formation of products. 840 23 THE KINETICS OF COMPLEX REACTIONS Acid catalysis is the primary process in the solvolysis of esters and keto–enol tautomerism. In base catalysis, a proton is transferred from the substrate to a base: XH + B → X− + BH+ X− → products Base catalysis is the primary step in the isomerization and halogenation of organic compounds, and of the Claisen and aldol condensation reactions. 23.6 Enzymes Enzymes are homogeneous biological catalysts. These ubiquitous compounds are special proteins or nucleic acids that contain an active site, which is responsible for binding the substrates, the reactants, and processing them into products. As is true of any catalyst, the active site returns to its original state after the products are released. Many enzymes consist primarily of proteins, some featuring organic or inorganic co-factors in their active sites. However, certain RNA molecules can also be biological catalysts, forming ribozymes. A very important example of a ribozyme is the ribosome, a large assembly of proteins and catalytically active RNA molecules responsible for the synthesis of proteins in the cell. The structure of the active site is specific to the reaction that it catalyses, with groups in the substrate interacting with groups in the active site by intermolecular interactions, such as hydrogen bonding, electrostatic, or van der Waals interactions. Figure 23.9 shows two models that explain the binding of a substrate to the active site of an enzyme. In the lock-and-key model, the active site and substrate have complementary three-dimensional structures and dock perfectly without the need for major atomic rearrangements. Experimental evidence favours the induced fit model, in which binding of the substrate induces a conformational change in the active site. Only after the change does the substrate fit snugly in the active site. Enzyme-catalysed reactions are prone to inhibition by molecules that interfere with the formation of product. Many drugs for the treatment of disease function by inhibiting enzymes. For example, an important strategy in the treatment of acquired immune deficiency syndrome (AIDS) involves the steady administration of a specially designed protease inhibitor. The drug inhibits an enzyme that is key to the formation of the protein envelope surrounding the genetic material of the human immunodeficiency virus (HIV). Without a properly formed envelope, HIV cannot replicate in the host organism. (a) The Michaelis–Menten mechanism of enzyme catalysis Experimental studies of enzyme kinetics are typically conducted by monitoring the initial rate of product formation in a solution in which the enzyme is present at very low concentration. Indeed, enzymes are such efficient catalysts that significant accelerations may be observed even when their concentration is more than three orders of magnitude smaller than that of the substrate. The principal features of many enzyme-catalysed reactions are as follows: 1 For a given initial concentration of substrate, [S]0, the initial rate of product formation is proportional to the total concentration of enzyme, [E]0. 2 For a given [E]0 and low values of [S]0, the rate of product formation is proportional to [S]0. 3 For a given [E]0 and high values of [S]0, the rate of product formation becomes independent of [S]0, reaching a maximum value known as the maximum velocity, vmax. S E ES Induced fit Lock and key Active site E S Fig. 23.9 Two models that explain the binding of a substrate to the active site of an enzyme. In the lock-and-key model, the active site and substrate have complementary three-dimensional structures and dock perfectly without the need for major atomic rearrangements. In the induced fit model, binding of the substrate induces a conformational change in the active site. The substrate fits well in the active site after the conformational change has taken place. 23.6 ENZYMES 841 The Michaelis–Menten mechanism accounts for these features. According to this mechanism, an enzyme–substrate complex is formed in the first step and either the substrate is released unchanged or after modification to form products: E + S 5 ES ka,k′a (23.16) ES → P kb We show in the following Justification that this mechanism leads to the Michaelis– Menten equation for the rate of product formation v = (23.17) where KM = (k′a + kb)/ka is the Michaelis constant, characteristic of a given enzyme acting on a given substrate. Justification 23.2 The Michaelis–Menten equation The rate of product formation according to the Michaelis–Menten mechanism is v = kb[ES] (23.18) We can obtain the concentration of the enzyme–substrate complex by invoking the steady-state approximation and writing = ka[E][S] − k′a[ES] − kb[ES] = 0 It follows that [ES] = [E][S] (23.19) where [E] and [S] are the concentrations of free enzyme and substrate, respectively. Now we define the Michaelis constant as KM = = and note that KM has the same units as molar concentration. To express the rate law in terms of the concentrations of enzyme and substrate added, we note that [E]0 = [E] + [ES]. Moreover, because the substrate is typically in large excess relative to the enzyme, the free substrate concentration is approximately equal to the initial substrate concentration and we can write [S] ≈ [S]0. It then follows that: [ES] = We obtain eqn 23.17 when we substitute this expression for [ES] into that for the rate of product formation (v = kb[ES]). Equation 23.17 shows that, in accord with experimental observations (Fig. 23.10): 1 When [S]0 << KM, the rate is proportional to [S]0: v = [S]0[E]0 (23.20a) 2 When [S]0 >> KM, the rate reaches its maximum value and is independent of [S]0: v = vmax = kb[E]0 (23.20b) ka KM [E]0 1 + KM/[S]0 [E][S] [ES] k′a + kb ka D E F ka k′a + kb A B C d[ES] dt kb[E]0 1 + Km/[S]0 Rateofreaction,v vmax Substrate concentration, [S] Fig. 23.10 The variation of the rate of an enzyme-catalysed reaction with substrate concentration. The approach to a maximum rate, vmax, for large [S] is explained by the Michaelis–Menten mechanism. Exploration Use the Michaelis–Menten equation to generate two families of curves showing the dependence of v on [S]: one in which KM varies but vmax is constant, and another in which vmax varies but KM is constant. 842 23 THE KINETICS OF COMPLEX REACTIONS 1/[S]0 1/v 0 Slope /= K vM max 1/vmax -1/KM Fig. 23.11 A Lineweaver–Burk plot for the analysis of an enzyme-catalysed reaction that proceeds by a Michaelis–Menten mechanism and the significance of the intercepts and the slope. Comment 23.1 The web site contains links to databases of enzymes. Substitution of the definitions of KM and vmax into eqn 23.17 gives: v = (23.21) We can rearrange this expression into a form that is amenable to data analysis by linear regression: = + (23.22) A Lineweaver–Burk plot is a plot of 1/v against 1/[S]0, and according to eqn 23.22 it should yield a straight line with slope of KM/vmax, a y-intercept at 1/vmax, and an xintercept at −1/KM (Fig. 23.11). The value of kb is then calculated from the y-intercept and eqn 23.20b. However, the plot cannot give the individual rate constants ka and k′a that appear in the expression for KM. The stopped-flow technique described in Section 22.1b can give the additional data needed, because we can find the rate of formation of the enzyme–substrate complex by monitoring the concentration after mixing the enzyme and substrate. This procedure gives a value for ka, and k′a is then found by combining this results with the values of kb and KM. (b) The catalytic efficiency of enzymes The turnover frequency, or catalytic constant, of an enzyme, kcat, is the number of catalytic cycles (turnovers) performed by the active site in a given interval divided by the duration of the interval. This quantity has units of a first-order rate constant and, in terms of the Michaelis–Menten mechanism, is numerically equivalent to kb, the rate constant for release of product from the enzyme–substrate complex. It follows from the identification of kcat with kb and from eqn 23.20b that kcat = kb = (23.23) The catalytic efficiency, ε (epsilon), of an enzyme is the ratio kcat/KM. The higher the value of ε, the more efficient is the enzyme. We can think of the catalytic activity as the effective rate constant of the enzymatic reaction. From KM = (k′a + kb)/ka and eqn 23.23, it follows that ε = = (23.24) The efficiency reaches its maximum value of ka when kb >> k′a. Because ka is the rate constant for the formation of a complex from two species that are diffusing freely in solution, the maximum efficiency is related to the maximum rate of diffusion of E and S in solution. This limit (which is discussed further in Section 24.2) leads to rate constants of about 108 –109 dm3 mol−1 s−1 for molecules as large as enzymes at room temperature. The enzyme catalase has ε = 4.0 × 108 dm3 mol−1 s−1 and is said to have attained ‘catalytic perfection’, in the sense that the rate of the reaction it catalyses is controlled only by diffusion: it acts as soon as a substrate makes contact. Example 23.3 Determining the catalytic efficiency of an enzyme The enzyme carbonic anhydrase catalyses the hydration of CO2 in red blood cells to give bicarbonate (hydrogencarbonate) ion: CO2(g) + H2O(l) → HCO3 − (aq) + H+ (aq) kakb k′a + kb kcat Km vmax [E]0 1 [S]0 D F KM vmax A C 1 vmax 1 v vmax 1 + KM/[S]0 23.6 ENZYMES 843 0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1 (mmol dm )/[CO ] -3 2 (mmoldms)/ --31 v 10 20 30 40 0 Fig. 23.12 The Lineweaver–Burk plot of the data for Example 23.3. The following data were obtained for the reaction at pH = 7.1, 273.5 K, and an enzyme concentration of 2.3 nmol dm−3 : [CO2]/(mmol dm−3 ) 1.25 2.5 5 20 rate/(mmol dm−3 s−1 ) 2.78 × 10−2 5.00 × 10−2 8.33 × 10−2 1.67 × 10−1 Determine the catalytic efficiency of carbonic anhydrase at 273.5 K. Method Prepare a Lineweaver–Burk plot and determine the values of KM and vmax by linear regression analysis. From eqn 23.23 and the enzyme concentration, calculate kcat and the catalytic efficiency from eqn 23.24. Answer We draw up the following table: 1/([CO2]/(mmol dm−3 )) 0.800 0.400 0.200 0.0500 1/(v/(mmol dm−3 s−1 )) 36.0 20.0 12.0 6.0 Figure 23.12 shows the Lineweaver–Burk plot for the data. The slope is 40.0 and the y-intercept is 4.00. Hence, vmax/(mmol dm−3 s−1 ) = = = 0.250 and KM/(mmol dm−3 ) = = = 10.0 It follows that kcat = = = 1.1 × 105 s−1 and ε = = = 1.1 × 107 dm3 mol−1 s−1 A note on good practice The slope and the intercept are unit-less: we have remarked previously, that all graphs should be plotted as pure numbers. Self-test 23.3 The enzyme α-chymotrypsin is secreted in the pancreas of mammals and cleaves peptide bonds made between certain amino acids. Several solutions containing the small peptide N-glutaryl-l-phenylalanine-p-nitroanilide at different concentrations were prepared and the same small amount of α-chymotrypsin was added to each one. The following data were obtained on the initial rates of the formation of product: [S]/(mmol dm−3 ) 0.334 0.450 0.667 1.00 1.33 1.67 v/(mmol dm−3 s−1 ) 0.152 0.201 0.269 0.417 0.505 0.667 Determine the maximum velocity and the Michaelis constant for the reaction. [vmax = 2.80 mmol dm−3 s−1 , KM = 5.89 mmol dm−3 ] 1.1 × 105 s−1 1.0 × 10−2 mol dm−3 kcat KM 2.5 × 10−4 mol dm−3 s−1 2.3 × 10−9 mol dm−3 vmax [E]0 40.0 4.00 slope intercept 1 4.00 1 intercept 844 23 THE KINETICS OF COMPLEX REACTIONS (c) Mechanisms of enzyme inhibition An inhibitor, I, decreases the rate of product formation from the substrate by binding to the enzyme, to the ES complex, or to the enzyme and ES complex simultaneously. The most general kinetic scheme for enzyme inhibition is then: E + S 5 ES ka, k′a ES → E + P kb EI 5 E + I KI = (23.25a) ESI 5 ES + I KS′ = (23.25b) The lower the values of KI and K′I the more efficient are the inhibitors. The rate of product formation is always given by v = kb[ES], because only ES leads to product. As shown in the following Justification, the rate of reaction in the presence of an inhibitor is v = (23.26) where α = 1 + [I]/KI and α′ = 1 + [I]/K′I. This equation is very similar to the Michaelis–Menten equation for the uninhibited enzyme (eqn 23.17) and is also amenable to analysis by a Lineweaver–Burk plot: = + (23.27) Justification 23.3 Enzyme inhibition By mass balance, the total concentration of enzyme is: [E]0 = [E] + [EI] + [ES] + [ESI] By using eqns 23.25a and 23.25b and the definitions α = 1 + and α′ = 1 + it follows that [E]0 = [E]α + [ES]α′ By using KM = [E][S]/[ES], we can write [E]0 = α + [ES]α′ = [ES] + α′ The expression for the rate of product formation is then: v = kb[ES] = which, upon rearrangement, gives eqn 23.26. There are three major modes of inhibition that give rise to distinctly different kinetic behaviour (Fig. 23.13). In competitive inhibition the inhibitor binds only to the active site of the enzyme and thereby inhibits the attachment of the substrate. This condition corresponds to α > 1 and α′ = 1 (because ESI does not form). The slope of kb[E]0 αKM/[S]0 + α′ D E F αKM [S]0 A B C KM[ES] [S]0 [I] K′I [I] KI 1 [S]0 D F αKM vmax A C α′ vmax 1 v vmax α′ + αKM/[S]0 [E][I] [EI] [E][I] [EI] 1/[S] 1/v 0 1/[S] 1/v 0 1/[S] 1/v 0 a a’ 1= = a a1, ’ 1> = a a’ 1= = a a’ 1= = a a1, ’ 1= > a a’ 1= > (a) (b) (c) a a a a a a a a a a a a Fig. 23.13 Lineweaver–Burk plots characteristic of the three major modes of enzyme inhibition: (a) competitive inhibition, (b) uncompetitive inhibition, and (c) non-competitive inhibition, showing the special case α = α′ > 1. Exploration Use eqn 23.26 to explore the effect of competitive, uncompetitive, and non-competitive inhibition on the shapes of the plots of v against [S] for constant KM and vmax. 23.7 KINETICS OF PHOTOPHYSICAL AND PHOTOCHEMICAL PROCESSES 845 the Lineweaver–Burk plot increases by a factor of α relative to the slope for data on the uninhibited enzyme (α = α′ = 1). The y-intercept does not change as a result of competitive inhibition (Fig. 23.13a). In uncompetitive inhibition the inhibitor binds to a site of the enzyme that is removed from the active site, but only if the substrate is already present. The inhibition occurs because ESI reduces the concentration of ES, the active type of complex. In this case α = 1 (because EI does not form) and α′ > 1. The y-intercept of the Lineweaver–Burk plot increases by a factor of α′ relative to the y-intercept for data on the uninhibited enzyme but the slope does not change (Fig. 23.13b). In non-competitive inhibition (also called mixed inhibition) the inhibitor binds to a site other than the active site, and its presence reduces the ability of the substrate to bind to the active site. Inhibition occurs at both the E and ES sites. This condition corresponds to α > 1 and α′ > 1. Both the slope and y-intercept of the Lineweaver–Burk plot increase upon addition of the inhibitor. Figure 23.13c shows the special case of KI = K′I and α = α′, which results in intersection of the lines at the x-axis. In all cases, the efficiency of the inhibitor may be obtained by determining KM and vmax from a control experiment with uninhibited enzyme and then repeating the experiment with a known concentration of inhibitor. From the slope and y-intercept of the Lineweaver–Burk plot for the inhibited enzyme (eqn 23.27), the mode of inhibition, the values of α or α′, and the values of KI or K′I may be obtained. Photochemistry Many reactions can be initiated by the absorption of electromagnetic radiation by one of the mechanisms described in Chapter 14. The most important of all are the photochemical processes that capture the radiant energy of the Sun. Some of these reactions lead to the heating of the atmosphere during the daytime by absorption of ultraviolet radiation (Impact I23.1). Others include the absorption of visible radiation during photosynthesis (Impact I7.2 and I23.2). Without photochemical processes, the Earth would be simply a warm, sterile, rock. Table 23.1 summarizes common photochemical reactions. 23.7 Kinetics of photophysical and photochemical processes Photochemical processes are initiated by the absorption of radiation by at least one component of a reaction mixture. In a primary process, products are formed directly from the excited state of a reactant. Examples include fluorescence (Section 14.3) and the cis–trans photoisomerization of retinal (Table 23.1, see also Impact I14.1). Products of asecondaryprocess originate from intermediates that are formed directly from the excited state of a reactant. Examples include photosynthesis and photochemical chain reactions (Section 23.8). Competing with the formation of photochemical products is a host of primary photophysical processes that can deactivate the excited state (Table 23.2). Therefore, it is important to consider the timescales of excited state formation and decay before describing the mechanisms of photochemical reactions. (a) Timescales of photophysical processes Electronic transitions caused by absorption of ultraviolet and visible radiation occur within 10−16 –10−15 s. We expect, then, that the upper limit for the rate constant of a first-order photochemical reaction is about 1016 s−1 . Fluorescence is slower than Comment 23.2 The web site contains links to databases on photochemical reactions. 846 23 THE KINETICS OF COMPLEX REACTIONS Table 23.1 Examples of photochemical processes Process General form Example Ionization A* → A+ + e− NO* –134 ––nm ––→ NO+ + e− Electron transfer A* + B → A+ + B− or A− + B+ [Ru(bpy)3 2+ ]* + Fe3+ –452 ––nm ––→ Ru(bpy)3 3+ + Fe2+ Dissociation A* → B + C O3* –1180 –––nm ––→ O2 + O A* + B-C → A + B + C Hg* + CH4 –254 ––nm ––→ Hg + CH3 + H Addition 2 A* → B A* + B → AB Abstraction A* + B-C → A-B + C Hg* + H2 –254 ––nm ––→ HgH + H Isomerization or A* → A′ rearrangement * Excited state. Table 23.2 Common photophysical processes† Primary absorption S + hν → S* Excited-state absorption S* + hν → S** T* + hν → T** Fluorescence S* → S + hν Stimulated emission S* + hν → S + 2hν Intersystem crossing (ISC) S* → T* Phosphorescence T* → S + hν Internal conversion (IC) S* → S Collision-induced emission S* + M → S + M + hν Collisional deactivation S* + M → S + M T* + M → S + M Electronic energy transfer: Singlet–singlet S* + S → S + S* Triple–triplet T* + T → T + T* Excimer formation S* + S → (SS)* Energy pooling Singlet–singlet S* + S* → S** + S Triple–triplet T* + T* → S* + S † S denotes a singlet state, T a triplet state, and M is a third body. 23.7 KINETICS OF PHOTOPHYSICAL AND PHOTOCHEMICAL PROCESSES 847 absorption, with typical lifetimes of 10−12 –10−6 s. Therefore, the excited singlet state can initiate very fast photochemical reactions in the femtosecond (10−15 s) to picosecond (10−12 s) timescale. Examples of such ultrafast reactions are the initial events of vision (Impact I14.1) and of photosynthesis. Typical intersystem crossing (ISC) and phosphorescence times for large organic molecules are 10−12 –10−4 s and 10−6 –10−1 s, respectively. As a consequence, excited triplet states are photochemically important. Indeed, because phosphorescence decay is several orders of magnitude slower than most typical reactions, species in excited triplet states can undergo a very large number of collisions with other reactants before deactivation. The interplay between reaction rates and excited state lifetimes is a very important factor in the determination of the kinetic feasibility of a photochemical process. Illustration 23.1 Exploring the photochemical roles of excited singlet and triplet states To estimate whether the excited singlet or triplet state of the reactant is a suitable product precursor, we compare the emission lifetimes with the relaxation time, τ, of the reactant due to the chemical reaction. As an illustration, consider a unimolecular photochemical reaction with rate constant k = 1.7 × 104 s−1 and relaxation time τ = 1/(1.7 × 104 s−1 ) = 59 µs that involves a reactant with an observed fluorescence lifetime of 1.0 ns and an observed phosphorescence lifetime of 1.0 ms. The excited singlet state is too short-lived and is not expected to be a major source of product in this reaction. On the other hand, the excited triplet state is a good candidate for a precursor. (b) The primary quantum yield We shall see that the rates of deactivation of the excited state by radiative, non-radiative, and chemical processes determine the yield of product in a photochemical reaction. The primary quantum yield, φ, is defined as the number of photophysical or photochemical events that lead to primary products divided by the number of photons absorbed by the molecule in the same interval. It follows that the primary quantum yield is also the rate of radiation-induced primary events divided by the rate of photon absorption. Because the rate of photon absorption is equal to the intensity of light absorbed by the molecule (Section 13.2), we write φ = = = [23.28] A molecule in an excited state must either decay to the ground state or form a photochemical product. Therefore, the total number of molecules deactivated by radiative processes, non-radiative processes, and photochemical reactions must be equal to the number of excited species produced by absorption of light. We conclude that the sum of primary quantum yields φi for all photophysical and photochemical events i must be equal to 1, regardless of the number of reactions involving the excited state. It follows that ∑ i φi = ∑ i = 1 (23.29) It follows that for an excited singlet state that decays to the ground state only via the photophysical processes described in Section 23.7(a), we write φf + φIC + φISC + φp = 1 vi Iabs v Iabs rate of process intensity of light absorbed number of events number of photons absorbed 848 23 THE KINETICS OF COMPLEX REACTIONS where φf, φIC, φISC, and φp are the quantum yields of fluorescence, internal conversion, intersystem crossing, and phosphorescence, respectively. The quantum yield of photon emission by fluorescence and phosphorescence is φemission = φf + φp, which is less than 1. If the excited singlet state also participates in a primary photochemical reaction with quantum yield φR, we write φf + φIC + φISC + φp + φR = 1 We can now strengthen the link between reaction rates and primary quantum yield already established by eqns 23.28 and 23.29. By taking the constant Iabs out of the summation in eqn 23.29 and rearranging, we obtain Iabs = ∑ivi. Substituting this result into eqn 23.29 gives the general result φi = (23.30) Therefore, the primary quantum yield may be determined directly from the experimental rates of all photophysical and photochemical processes that deactivate the excited state. (c) Mechanism of decay of excited singlet states Consider the formation and decay of an excited singlet state in the absense of a chemical reaction: Absorption: S + hνi → S* vabs = Iabs Fluorescence: S* → S + hνf vf = kf[S*] Internal conversion: S* → S vIC = kIC[S*] Intersystem crossing: S* → T* vISC = kISC[S*] in which S is an absorbing species, S* an excited singlet state, T* an excited triplet state, and hνi and hνf are the energies of the incident and fluorescent photons, respectively. From the methods developed in Chapter 22 and the rates of the steps that form and destroy the excited singlet state S*, we write the rate of formation and decay of S* as: Rate of formation of [S*] = Iabs Rate of decay of [S*] = −kf[S*] − kISC[S*] − kIC[S*] = −(kf + kISC + kIC)[S*] It follows that the excited state decays by a first-order process so, when the light is turned off, the concentration of S* varies with time t as: [S*]t = [S*]0e−t/τ0 (23.31) where the observed fluorescence lifetime, τ0, is defined as: τ0 = (23.32) We show in the following Justification that the quantum yield of fluorescence is φf = (23.33) kf kf + kISC + kIC 1 kf + kISC + kIC vi ∑ i vi 23.7 KINETICS OF PHOTOPHYSICAL AND PHOTOCHEMICAL PROCESSES 849 Justification 23.4 The quantum yield of fluorescence Most fluorescence measurements are conducted by illuminating a relatively dilute sample with a continuous and intense beam of light. It follows that [S*] is small and constant, so we may invoke the steady-state approximation (Section 22.7) and write: = Iabs − kf[S*] − kISC[S*] − kIC[S*] = Iabs − (kf + kISC + kIC)[S*] = 0 Consequently, Iabs = (kf + kISC + kIC)[S*] By using this expression and eqn 23.28, the quantum yield of fluorescence is written as: φf = = which, by cancelling the [S*], simplifies to eqn 23.33. The observed fluorescence lifetime can be measured with a pulsed laser technique (Section 13.12b). First, the sample is excited with a short light pulse from a laser using a wavelength at which S absorbs strongly. Then, the exponential decay of the fluorescence intensity after the pulse is monitored. From eqn 13.28, it follows that τ0 = = × = (23.34) Illustration 23.2 Calculating the fluorescence rate constant of tryptophan In water, the fluorescence quantum yield and observed fluorescence lifetime of tryptophan are φf = 0.20 and τ0 = 2.6 ns, respectively. It follows from eqn 23.33 that the fluorescence rate constant kf is kf = = = 7.7 × 107 s−1 (d) Quenching The shortening of the lifetime of the excited state is called quenching. Quenching may be either a desired process, such as in energy or electron transfer, or an undesired side reaction that can decrease the quantum yield of a desired photochemical process. Quenching effects may be studied by monitoring the emission from the excited state that is involved in the photochemical reaction. The addition of a quencher, Q, opens an additional channel for deactivation of S*: Quenching: S* + Q → S + Q vQ = kQ[Q][S*] The Stern–Volmer equation, which is derived in the Justification below, relates the fluorescence quantum yields φf,0 and φf measured in the absence and presence, respectively, of a quencher Q at a molar concentration [Q]: = 1 + τ0kQ[Q] (23.35) φf,0 φf 0.20 2.6 × 10−9 s φf τ0 φf kf 1 kf D F kf kf + kISC + kIC A C 1 kf + kISC + kIC kf[S*] (kf + kISC + kIC)[S*] vf Iabs d[S*] dt 850 23 THE KINETICS OF COMPLEX REACTIONS ff/ [Q] Slope = 0kQt 0 1 t ff Fig. 23.14 The format of a Stern–Volmer plot and the interpretation of the slope in terms of the rate constant for quenching and the observed fluorescence lifetime in the absence of quenching. This equation tells us that a plot of φf,0/φf against [Q] should be a straight line with slope τ0kQ. Such a plot is called a Stern–Volmer plot (Fig. 23.14). The method may also be applied to the quenching of phosphorescence. Justification 23.5 The Stern–Volmer equation With the addition of quenching, the steady-state approximation for [S*] now gives: = Iabs − (kf + kIC + kISC + kIC + kQ[Q])[S*] = 0 and the fluorescence quantum yield in the presence of the quencher is: φf = When [Q] = 0, the quantum yield is φf,0 = It follows that = × = = 1 + [Q] By using eqn 23.34, this expression simplifies to eqn 23.35. Because the fluorescence intensity and lifetime are both proportional to the fluorescence quantum yield (specifically, from eqn 23.34, τ = φf/kf), plots of If,0/If and τ0/τ (where the subscript 0 indicates a measurement in the absence of quencher) against [Q] should also be linear with the same slope and intercept as those shown for eqn 23.35. Example 23.4 Determining the quenching rate constant The molecule 2,2′-bipyridine (1) forms a complex with the Ru2+ ion. Ruthenium(II) tris-(2,2′-bipyridyl), Ru(bipy)3 2+ (2), has a strong metal-to-ligand charge transfer (MLCT) transition (Section 14.2) at 450 nm. The quenching of the *Ru(bipy)3 2+ excited state by Fe(H2O)6 3+ in acidic solution was monitored by measuring emission lifetimes at 600 nm. Determine the quenching rate constant for this reaction from the following data: [Fe(H2O)6 3+ ]/(10−4 mol dm−3 ) 0 1.6 4.7 7 9.4 t/(10−7 s) 6 4.05 3.37 2.96 2.17 Method Re-write the Stern–Volmer equation (eqn 23.35) for use with lifetime data then fit the data to a straight-line. Answer Upon substitution of τ0/τ for φ0,f/φf in eqn 23.35 and after rearrangement, we obtain: kQ kf + kISC + kIC kf + kISC + kIC + kQ[Q] kf + kISC + kIC D E F kf + kISC + kIC + kQ[Q] kf A B C D E F kf kf + kISC + kIC A B C φf,0 φf kf kf + kISC + kIC kf kf + kISC + kIC + kQ[Q] d[S*] dt 23.7 KINETICS OF PHOTOPHYSICAL AND PHOTOCHEMICAL PROCESSES 851 0 0.5 1 [Fe ]/(10 mol dm ) 3 3 3+ - - 1.0 2.0 3.0 4.0 5.0 (10s)/ 61- t Fig. 23.15 The Stern–Volmer plot of the data for Example 23.4. = + kQ[Q] (23.36) Figure 23.15 shows a plot of 1/τ versus [Fe3+ ] and the results of a fit to eqn 23.36. The slope of the line is 2.8 × 109 , so kQ = 2.8 × 109 dm3 mol−1 s−1 . This example shows that measurements of emission lifetimes are preferred because they yield the value of kQ directly. To determine the value of kQ from intensity or quantum yield measurements, we need to make an independent measurement of τ0. Self-test 23.4 The quenching of tryptophan fluorescence by dissolved O2 gas was monitored by measuring emission lifetimes at 348 nm in aqueous solutions. Determine the quenching rate constant for this process from the following data: [O2]/(10−2 mol dm−3 ) 0 2.3 5.5 8 10.8 τ/(10−9 s) 2.6 1.5 0.92 0.71 0.57 [1.3 × 1010 dm3 mol−1 s−1 ] Three common mechanisms for bimolecular quenching of an excited singlet (or triplet) state are: Collisional deactivation: S* + Q → S + Q Resonance energy transfer: S* + Q → S + Q* Electron transfer: S* + Q → S+ + Q− or S− + Q+ Collisional quenching is particularly efficient when Q is a heavy species, such as iodide ion, which receives energy from S* and then decays primarily by internal conversion to the ground state. This fact may be used to determine the accessibility of amino acid residues of a folded protein to solvent. For example, fluorescence from a tryptophan residue (λabs ≈ 290 nm, λfluor ≈ 350 nm) is quenched by iodide ion when the residue is on the surface of the protein and hence accessible to the solvent. Conversely, residues in the hydrophobic interior of the protein are not quenched effectively by I− . The quenching rate constant itself does not give much insight into the mechanism of quenching. For the system of Example 23.4, it is known that the quenching of the excited state of Ru(bipy)3 2+ is a result of light-induced electron transfer to Fe3+ , but the quenching data do not allow us to prove the mechanism. However, there are some criteria that govern the relative efficiencies of energy and electron transfer. (e) Resonance energy transfer We visualize the process S* + Q → S + Q* as follows. The oscillating electric field of the incoming electromagnetic radiation induces an oscillating electric dipole moment in S. Energy is absorbed by S if the frequency of the incident radiation, ν, is such that ν = ∆ES/h, where ∆ES is the energy separation between the ground and excited electronic states of S and h is Planck’s constant. This is the ‘resonance condition’ for absorption of radiation. The oscillating dipole on S now can affect electrons bound to a nearby Q molecule by inducing an oscillating dipole moment in the latter. If the frequency of oscillation of the electric dipole moment in S is such that ν = ∆EQ/h then Q will absorb energy from S. The efficiency, ET, of resonance energy transfer is defined as ET = 1 − [23.37] φf φf,0 1 τ0 1 τ 852 23 THE KINETICS OF COMPLEX REACTIONS Table 23.3 Values of R0 for some donor–acceptor pairs* Donor† Acceptor R0 /nm Naphthalene Dansyl 2.2 Dansyl ODR 4.3 Pyrene Coumarin 3.9 IEDANS FITC 4.9 Tryptophan IEDANS 2.2 Tryptophan Haem (heme) 2.9 * Additional values may be found in J.R. Lacowicz in Principles of fluorescence spectroscopy, Kluwer Academic/Plenum, New York (1999). † Abbreviations: Dansyl, 5-dimethylamino-1naphthalenesulfonic acid; FITC, fluorescein 5-isothiocyanate; IEDANS, 5-((((2-iodoacetyl) amino)ethyl)amino)naphthalene-1-sulfonic acid; ODR, octadecyl-rhodamine. Intensity Frequency, n Absorption spectrum of Q Emission spectrum of S* n Fig. 23.16 According to the Förster theory, the rate of energy transfer from a molecule S* in an excited state to a quencher molecule Q is optimized at radiation frequencies in which the emission spectrum of S* overlaps with the absorption spectrum of Q, as shown in the shaded region. According to the Förster theory of resonance energy transfer, which was proposed by T. Förster in 1959, energy transfer is efficient when: 1 The energy donor and acceptor are separated by a short distance (of the order of nanometres). 2 Photons emitted by the excited state of the donor can be absorbed directly by the acceptor. We show in Further information 23.1 that for donor–acceptor systems that are held rigidly either by covalent bonds or by a protein ‘scaffold’, ET increases with decreasing distance, R, according to ET = (23.38) where R0 is a parameter (with units of distance) that is characteristic of each donor–acceptor pair. Equation 23.38 has been verified experimentally and values of R0 are available for a number of donor–acceptor pairs (Table 23.3). The emission and absorption spectra of molecules span a range of wavelengths, so the second requirement of the Förster theory is met when the emission spectrum of the donor molecule overlaps significantly with the absorption spectrum of the acceptor. In the overlap region, photons emitted by the donor have the proper energy to be absorbed by the acceptor (Fig. 23.16). In many cases, it is possible to prove that energy transfer is the predominant mechanism of quenching if the excited state of the acceptor fluoresces or phosphoresces at a characteristic wavelength. In a pulsed laser experiment, the rise in fluorescence intensity from Q* with a characteristic time that is the same as that for the decay of the fluorescence of S* is often taken as indication of energy transfer from S to Q. Equation 23.38 forms the basis of fluorescence resonance energy transfer (FRET), in which the dependence of the energy transfer efficiency, ET, on the distance, R, between energy donor and acceptor can be used to measure distances in biological systems. In a typical FRET experiment, a site on a biopolymer or membrane is labelled covalently with an energy donor and another site is labelled covalently with an energy acceptor. In certain cases, the donor or acceptor may be natural constituents of the system, such as amino acid groups, cofactors, or enzyme substrates. The distance between the labels is then calculated from the known value of R0 and eqn 23.38. Several tests have shown that the FRET technique is useful for measuring distances ranging from 1 to 9 nm. Illustration 23.3 Using FRET analysis As an illustration of the FRET technique, consider a study of the protein rhodopsin (Impact I14.1). When an amino acid on the surface of rhodopsin was labelled covalently with the energy donor 1.5-I AEDANS (3), the fluorescence quantum yield of the label decreased from 0.75 to 0.68 due to quenching by the visual pigment 11-cis-retinal (4). From eqn 23.37, we calculate ET = 1 − (0.68/0.75) = 0.093 and from eqn 23.38 and the known value of R0 = 5.4 nm for the 1.5-I AEDANS/11-cis-retinal pair we calculate R = 7.9 nm. Therefore, we take 7.9 nm to be the distance between the surface of the protein and 11-cis-retinal. If donor and acceptor molecules diffuse in solution or in the gas phase, Förster theory predicts that the efficiency of quenching by energy transfer increases as the R6 0 R6 0 + R6 I23.1 IMPACT ON ENVIRONMENTAL SCIENCE: THE CHEMISTRY OF STRATOSPHERIC OZONE 853 average distance travelled between collisions of donor and acceptor decreases. That is, the quenching efficiency increases with concentration of quencher, as predicted by the Stern–Volmer equation. (f) Electron transfer reactions According to the Marcus theory of electron transfer, which was proposed by R.A. Marcus in 1965 and is discussed fully in Section 24.11, the rates of electron transfer (from ground or excited states) depend on: 1 The distance between the donor and acceptor, with electron transfer becoming more efficient as the distance between donor and acceptor decreases. 2 The reaction Gibbs energy, ∆rG, with electron transfer becoming more efficient as the reaction becomes more exergonic. For example, efficient photooxidation of S requires that the reduction potential of S* be lower than the reduction potential of Q. 3 The reorganization energy, the energy cost incurred by molecular rearrangements of donor, acceptor, and medium during electron transfer. The electron transfer rate is predicted to increase as this reorganization energy is matched closely by the reaction Gibbs energy. Electron transfer can also be studied by time-resolved spectroscopy (Section 14.6). The oxidized and reduced products often have electronic absorption spectra distinct from those of their neutral parent compounds. Therefore, the rapid appearance of such known features in the absorption spectrum after excitation by a laser pulse may be taken as indication of quenching by electron transfer. IMPACT ON ENVIRONMENTAL SCIENCE I23.1 The chemistry of stratospheric ozone The Earth’s atmosphere contains primarily N2 and O2 gas, with low concentrations of a large number of other species of both natural and anthropogenic origins. Indeed, many of the natural trace constituents of our atmosphere participate in complex chemical reactions that have contributed to the proliferation of life on the planet. The development of industrial societies has added new components to the Earth’s atmosphere and has led to significant changes in the concentrations of some natural trace species. The negative consequences of these changes for the environment are either already being felt or, more disturbingly, are yet to be felt in the next few decades (see, for example, the discussion of global warming in Impact I13.2). Careful kinetic analysis allows us to understand the origins of our complex atmosphere and point to ways in which environmental problems can be solved or avoided. The Earth’s atmosphere consists of layers, as shown in Fig. 23.17. The pressure decreases as altitude increases (see Problems 1.27 and 16.20), but the variation of temperature with altitude is complex, owing to processes that capture radiant energy from the Sun. We focus on the stratosphere, a region spanning from 15 km to 50 km above the surface of the Earth, and on the chemistry of the trace component ozone, O3. In the troposphere, the region between the Earth’s surface and the stratosphere, temperature decreases with increasing altitude. This behaviour may be understood in terms of a model in which the boundary between the troposphere and the stratosphere, also called the tropopause, is considered adiabatic. Then we know from Section 2.6 that, as atmospheric gases are allowed to expand from layers close to the surface to higher layers, the temperature varies with pressure, and hence height, as = c c = − 1 Cp,m CV,m D F plow altitude phigh altitude A C Tlow altitude Thigh altitude 854 23 THE KINETICS OF COMPLEX REACTIONS The model predicts a decrease in temperature with increasing altitude because Cp,m/ CV,m ≈ 7 –5 for air. In the stratosphere, a temperature inversion is observed because of photochemical chain reactions that produce ozone from O2. The Chapman model accounts for ozone formation and destruction in an atmosphere that contains only O2: Initiation: O2 + hν → O + O 185 nm < λ < 220 nm v = k1[O2] Propagation: O + O2 + M → O3 + M* ∆rH = −106.6 kJ mol−1 v = k2[O][O2][M] O3 + hν → O2 + O 210 nm < λ < 300 nm v = k3[O3] Termination: O + O3 → O2 + O2 ∆rH = −391.9 kJ mol−1 v = k4[O][O3] O + O + M → O2 + M* v = k5[O]2 [M] where M is an arbitrary third body, such as O2 in an ‘oxygen-only’ atmosphere, which helps to remove excess energy from the products of combination and recombination reactions. The mechanism shows that absorption of radiation by O2 and O3 during the daytime leads to the production of reactive O atoms, which, in turn, participate in exothermic reactions that are responsible for the heating of the stratosphere. Using values of the rate constants that are applicable to stratospheric conditions, the Chapman model predicts a net formation of trace amounts of ozone, as seen in Fig. 23.18 (see also Problem 23.33). However, the model overestimates the concentration of ozone in the stratosphere because other trace species X contribute to catalytic enhancement of the termination step O3 + O → O2 + O2 according to X + O3 → XO + O2 XO + O → X + O2 150 500 1000 1500 T/K 0 100 200 300 Altitude/km Thermosphere Mesosphere Stratosphere Troposphere -7 -6 -5 -4 -3 -2 -1 0 1 2 log(/Torr)p O O e+ ® +h + - n N N N2 + ® +hn O O O3 2+ ® +hn N O NO N2 + + + ® + N O N O2 2 2 2 + + + ® + O O e2 2+ ® +h + - n O O O O+ + + ® +2 2 O N NO N+ + + ® +2 O N NO NO2 2 + + + ® + O O e2 2+ ® +h + - n N N e2 2+ ® +h + - n N N e+ ® +h + - n NO NO e+ ® +h + - n O O O2 + ® +hn O N NO NO2 2 + + + ® + N O NO N2 + + + ® + N O N O2 2 2 2 + + + ® + O e O O+ + ® + NO e N O + + ® + - Tropopause Stratopause Mesopause n n n n n n n n n Fig. 23.17 The temperature profile through the atmosphere and some of the reactions that occur in each region. 23.1 IMPACT ON ENVIROMENTAL SCIENCE: THE CHEMISTRY OF STRATOSPHERIC OZONE 855 The catalyst X can be H, OH, NO, or Cl. Chlorine atoms are produced by photolysis of CH3Cl which, in turn, is a by-product of reactions between Cl− and decaying vegetation in oceans. Nitric oxide, NO, is produced in the stratosphere from reaction between excited oxygen atoms and N2O, which is formed mainly by microbial denitrification processes in soil. The hydroxyl radical is a product, along with the methyl radical, of the reaction between excited oxygen atoms and methane gas, which is a by-product of a number of natural processes (such as digestion of cellulose in ruminant animals, anaerobic decomposition of organic waste matter) and industrial processes (such as food production and fossil fuel use). In spite of the presence of these catalysts, a natural stratosphere is still capable to maintain a low concentration of ozone. The chemistry outlined above shows that the photochemical reactions of the Chapman model account for absorption of a significant portion of solar ultraviolet radiation in the stratosphere. Hence, the surface of the Earth is bathed by lower energy radiation, which does not damage biological tissue (see Impact I23.3). However, some pollutants can lower the concentration of stratospheric ozone. For example, chlorofluorocarbons (CFCs) have been used as propellants and refrigerants over many years. As CFC molecules diffuse slowly into the middle stratosphere, they are finally photolysed by ultraviolet radiation. For CF2Cl2, also known as CFC-12, the reaction is: CF2Cl2 + hν → CF2Cl + Cl We already know that the resulting Cl atoms can participate in the decomposition of ozone according to the catalytic cycle shown in Fig. 23.19. A number of experimental observations have linked this chemistry of CFCs to a dangerously rapid decline in the concentration of stratospheric ozone over the last three decades. Ozone depletion has increased the amount of ultraviolet radiation at the Earth’s surface, particularly radiation in the ‘UVB range’, 290–320 nm. The physiological consequences of prolonged exposure to UVB radiation include DNA damage, principally by photodimerization of adjacent thymine bases to yield either a cyclobutane 0 1 2 0 20 40 t/ms [O],[O]/(10moleculescm)3 83- O3 O 0 100 200 300 t/min 5 10 0 [O]/(10moleculescm) 93- t/min 0 [O]/(10moleculescm)3 133- 2 4 0 100 200 300 (a) (b) (c) Fig. 23.18 Net formation of ozone via the Chapman model in a stratospheric model containing only O2, O, andO3. The rate constants are consistent with reasonable stratospheric conditions. (a) Early reaction period after irradiation begins at t = 0. (b) Late reaction period, showing that the concentration of O atoms begins to level off after about 4 hours of continuous irradiation. (c) Late reaction period, showing that the ozone concentration also begins to level off similarly. For details of the calculation, see Problem 23.33 and M.P. Cady and C.A. Trapp, A Mathcad primer for physical chemistry. Oxford University Press (1999). Cl ClO O3 O2 O2 O Fig. 23.19 A catalytic cycle showing the propagation of ozone decomposition by chlorine atoms. 856 23 THE KINETICS OF COMPLEX REACTIONS thymine dimer (5) or a so-called 6–4 photoproduct (6). The former has been linked directly to cell death and the latter may lead to DNA mutations and, consequently, to the formation of tumours. There are several natural mechanisms for protection from and repair of photochemical damage. For example, the enzyme DNA photolyase, present in organisms from all kingdoms but not in humans, catalyses the destruction of cyclobutane thymine dimers. Also, ultraviolet radiation can induce the production of the pigment melanin (in a process more commonly known as ‘tanning’), which shields the skin from damage. However, repair and protective mechanisms become increasingly less effective with persistent and prolonged exposure to solar radiation. Consequently, there is concern that the depletion of stratospheric ozone may lead to an increase in mortality not only of animals but also the plants and lower organisms that form the base of the food chain. Chlorofluorocarbons are being phased out according to international agreements and alternatives, such as the hydrofluorocarbon CH2FCH3, are already being used. However, the temperature inversion shown in Fig. 23.17 leads to trapping of gases in the troposphere, so CFCs are likely to continue to cause ozone depletion over many decades as the molecules diffuse slowly into the middle stratosphere, where they are photolysed by intense solar UV radiation. IMPACT ON BIOCHEMISTRY I23.2 Harvesting of light during plant photosynthesis A large proportion of solar radiation with wavelengths below 400 nm and above 1000 nm is absorbed by atmospheric gases such as ozone and O2, which absorb ultraviolet radiation (Impact I23.1), and CO2 and H2O, which absorb infrared radiation (Impact I13.2). As a result, plants, algae, and some species of bacteria evolved photosynthetic apparatus that capture visible and near-infrared radiation. Plants use radiation in the wavelength range of 400–700 nm to drive the endergonic reduction of CO2 to glucose, with concomitant oxidation of water to O2 (∆rG⊕ = +2880 kJ mol−1 ), in essence the reverse of glycolysis and the citric acid cycle (Impact I7.2): 6 CO2(g) + 6 H2O(l) ––––––pho –––to –syn –––the ––sis ––––––→ C6H12O6(s) + 6 O2(g)←gly —col —ysis — a –nd —the —cit —ric —ac –id —cy –cle — Electrons flow from reductant to oxidant via a series of electrochemical reactions that are coupled to the synthesis of ATP. The process takes place in the chloroplast, a special organelle of the plant cell, where chlorophylls a and b (7) and carotenoids (of which β-carotene, 8, is an example) bind to integral proteins called light harvesting complexes, which absorb solar energy and transfer it to protein complexes known as reaction centres, where light-induced electron transfer reactions occur. The combination of a light harvesting complex and a reaction centre complex is called a photosystem. Plants have two photosystems that drive the reduction of NADP+ (9) by water: 2 H2O + 2 NADP+ –lig ––ht, –p –h –o –to –sys ––te –m –s –I –a –n –d –II –→ O2 + 2 NADPH + 2 H+ It is clear that energy from light is required to drive this reaction because, in the dark, E⊕ = −1.135 V and ∆rG⊕ = +438.0 kJ mol−1 . Light harvesting complexes bind large numbers of pigments in order to provide a sufficiently large area for capture of radiation. In photosystems I and II, absorption of a photon raises a chlorophyll or carotenoid molecule to an excited singlet state and within 0.1–5 ps the energy hops to a nearby pigment via the Förster mechanism (Section 23.7e). About 100–200 ps later, which corresponds to thousands of hops within the light harvesting complex, more than 90 per cent of the absorbed energy reaches the reaction centre. There, a chlorophyll a dimer becomes electronically I23.2 IMPACT ON BIOCHEMISTRY: HARVESTING OF LIGHT DURING PLANT PHOTOSYNTHESIS 857 excited and initiates ultrafast electron transfer reactions. For example, the transfer of an electron from the excited singlet state of P680, the chlorophyll dimer of the photosystem II reaction centre, to its immediate electron acceptor, a phaeophytin a molecule (a chlorophyll a molecule where the central Mg2+ ion is replaced by two protons, which are bound to two of the pyrrole nitrogens in the ring), occurs within 3 ps. Once the excited state of P680 has been quenched efficiently by this first reaction, subsequent steps that lead to the oxidation of water occur more slowly, with reaction times varying from 200 ps to 1 ms. The electrochemical reactions within the photosystem I reaction centre also occur in this time interval. We see that the initial energy and electron transfer events of photosynthesis are under tight kinetic control. Photosynthesis captures solar energy efficiently because the excited singlet state of chlorophyll is quenched rapidly by processes that occur with relaxation times that are much shorter than the fluorescence lifetime, which is typically about 1 ns in organic solvents at room temperature. Working together, photosystem I and the enzyme ferredoxin:NADP+ oxidored- uctasecatalysethelight-inducedoxidationofNADP+ toNADPH.Theelectronsrequired for this process come initially from P700 in its excited state. The resulting P700+ is then reduced by the mobile carrier plastocyanin (Pc), a protein in which the bound copper ion can exist in oxidation states +2 and +1. The net reaction is NADP+ + 2 Cu+ (Pc) + H+ –lig ––ht, ––p –h –o –to –sys ––te –m ––I –→ NADPH + 2 Cu2+ (Pc) Oxidized plastocyanin accepts electrons from reduced plastoquinone (PQ, 10). The process is catalysed by the cytochrome b6 f complex, a membrane protein complex that resembles complex III of mitochondria (Impact I7.2): PQH2 + 2 Cu2+ (Pc) –c –yt ––b –6 f ––c –o –m –p –lex –→ PQ + 2 H+ + 2 Cu+ (Pc) E⊕ = +0.370 V, ∆rG⊕ = −71.4 kJ mol−1 858 23 THE KINETICS OF COMPLEX REACTIONS This reaction is sufficiently exergonic to drive the synthesis of ATP in the process known as photophosphorylation. Plastoquinone is reduced by water in a process catalysed by light and photosystem II. The electrons required for the reduction of plastoquinone come initially from P680 in its excited state. The resulting P680+ is then reduced ultimately by water. The net reaction is H2O + PQ –lig ––ht, ––p –h –o –to –sys ––te –m ––II –→ 1 –2 O2 + PQH2 In this way, plant photosynthesis uses an abundant source of electrons (water) and of energy (the Sun) to drive the endergonic reduction of NADP+ , with concomitant synthesis of ATP (Fig. 23.20). Experiments show that, for each molecule of NADPH formed in the chloroplast of green plants, one molecule of ATP is synthesized. The ATP and NADPH molecules formed by the light-induced electron transfer reactions of plant photosynthesis participate directly in the reduction of CO2 to glucose in the chloroplast: 6 CO2 + 12 NADPH + 12 ATP + 12 H+ → C6H12O6 + 12 NADP+ + 12 ADP + 12 Pi + 6H2O In summary, plant photosynthesis uses solar energy to transfer electrons from a poor reductant (water) to carbon dioxide. In the process, high energy molecules (carbohydrates, such as glucose) are synthesized in the cell. Animals feed on the carbohydrates derived from photosynthesis. During aerobic metabolism, the O2 released by photosynthesis as a waste product is used to oxidize carbohydrates to CO2, driving biological processes, such as biosynthesis, muscle contraction, cell division, and nerve conduction. Hence, the sustenance of life on Earth depends on a tightly regulated carbon–oxygen cycle that is driven by solar energy. 23.8 Complex photochemical processes Many photochemical processes have complex mechanisms that may be examined by considering the concepts developed above. In this section, we consider two examples: photochemical chain reactions and photosensitization. Cu (Pc)2+ O2 P680* P680 h PSII H O2 ADP P680 + PQH2 e - PQ eCu (Pc) + e- e- ATP P700* P700 h PSI and NADP :ferredoxin oxidoreductase + P700 + NADPH e - NADP + e - e- n n Fig. 23.20 In plant photosynthesis, lightinduced electron transfer processes lead to the oxidation of water to O2 and the reduction of NADP+ to NADPH, with concomitant production of ATP. The energy stored in ATP and NADPH is used to reduce CO2 to carbohydrate in a separate set of reactions. The scheme summarizes the general patterns of electron flow and does not show all the intermediate electron carriers in photosystems I and II, the cytochrome b6 f complex, and ferredoxin:NADP+ oxidoreductase. 23.8 COMPLEX PHOTOCHEMICAL PROCESSES 859 (a) The overall quantum yield of a photochemical reaction For complex reactions involving secondary processes, such as chain reactions initiated by photolysis, many reactant molecules might be consumed as a result of absorption of a single photon. The overall quantum yield, Φ, for such reactions, the number of reactant molecules consumed per photon absorbed, might exceed 1. In the photolysis of HI, for example, the processes are HI + hν → H· + I· H· + HI → H2 + I· I· + I· + M → I2 + M* The overall quantum yield is 2 because the absorption of one photon leads to the destruction of two HI molecules. In a chain reaction, Φ may be very large, and values of about 104 are common. In such cases the chain acts as a chemical amplifier of the initial absorption step. Example 23.5 Determining the quantum yield of a photochemical reaction When a sample of 4-heptanone was irradiated for 100 s with 313 nm radiation with a power output of 50 W under conditions of total absorption, it was found that 2.8 mmol C2H4 was formed. What is the quantum yield for the formation of ethene? Method First, calculate the amount of photons generated in an interval ∆t: see Example 8.1. Then divide the amount of ethene molecules formed by the amount of photons absorbed. Answer From Example 8.1, the amount (in moles) of photons absorbed is n = If nC2H4 is the amount of ethene formed, the quantum yield is Φ = = = = 0.21 Self-test 23.5 The overall quantum yield for another reaction at 290 nm is 0.30. For what length of time must irradiation with a 100 W source continue in order to destroy 1.0 mol of molecules? [3.8 h] (b) Rate laws of complex photochemical reactions As an example of how to write a rate law for a complex photochemical process, consider the photochemical activation of the reaction H2(g) + Br2(g) → 2 HBr(g) In place of the first step in the thermal reaction we have Br2 + hν → Br· + Br· v = Iabs where Iabs is the number of photons of the appropriate frequency absorbed divided by the volume in which absorption occurs and the time interval. We are assuming a (2.8 × 10−3 mol) × (6.022 × 1023 mol−1 ) × (6.626 × 10−34 J s) × (2.997 × 108 m s−1 ) (3.13 × 10−7 m) × (50 J s−1 ) × (100 s) nC2H4 NAhc λP∆t nC2H4 n P∆t (hc/λ)NA 860 23 THE KINETICS OF COMPLEX REACTIONS primary quantum yield of unity for the photodissociation of Br2. It follows that Iabs should take the place of ki[Br2][M] in the thermal reaction scheme, so from Example 23.1 we can write = (23.39) We predict that the reaction rate should depend on the square root of the absorbed light intensity, which is confirmed experimentally. (c) Photosensitization The reactions of a molecule that does not absorb directly can be made to occur if another absorbing molecule is present, because the latter may be able to transfer its energy to the former during a collision. An example of this photosensitization is the reaction used to generate excited state O2 in a type of treatment known as photodynamic therapy (Impact I23.3). Another example is the reaction used to generate atomic hydrogen, the irradiation of hydrogen gas containing a trace of mercury vapour using radiation of wavelength 254 nm from a mercury discharge lamp. The Hg atoms are excited (to Hg*) by resonant absorption of the radiation, and then collide with H2 molecules. Two reactions then take place: Hg* + H2 → Hg + H· + H· Hg* + H2 → HgH + H· The latter reaction is the initiation step for other mercury photosensitized reactions, such as the synthesis of formaldehyde from carbon monoxide and hydrogen: H· + CO → HCO · HCO · + H2 → HCHO + H· HCO · + HCO · → HCHO + CO Notethatthelaststepisterminationbydisproportionationratherthanbycombination. IMPACT ON MEDICINE I23.3 Photodynamic therapy In photodynamic therapy (PDT), laser radiation, which is usually delivered to diseased tissue through a fibre optic cable, is absorbed by a drug which, in its first excited triplet state 3 P, photosensitizes the formation of an excited singlet state of O2, 1 O2. The 1 O2 molecules are very reactive and destroy cellular components and it is thought that cell membranes are the primary cellular targets. Hence, the photochemical cycle below leads to the shrinkage (and sometimes total destruction) of diseased tissue. Absorption: P + hν → P* Intersystem crossing: P* → 3 P Photosensitization: 3 P + 3 O2 → P + 1 O2 Oxidation reactions: 1 O2 + reactants → products The photosensitizer is hence a ‘photocatalyst’ for the production of 1 O2. It is common practice to use a porphyrin photosensitizer, such as compounds derived from haematoporphyrin (11). However, much effort is being expended to develop better drugs with enhanced photochemical properties. A potential PDT drug must meet many criteria. From the point of view of pharmacological effectiveness, the drug must be soluble in tissue fluids, so it can be transported to the diseased organ through blood and secreted from the body through 2kp(1/kt[M])1/2 [H2][Br2]Iabs 1/2 [Br2] + (kr/k′p)[HBr] d[HBr] dt CHECKLIST OF KEY IDEAS 861 urine. The therapy should also result in very few side effects. The drug must also have unique photochemical properties. It must be activated photochemically at wavelengths that are not absorbed by blood and skin. In practice, this means that the drug should have a strong absorption band at λ > 650 nm. Drugs based on haematoporphyrin do not meet this criterion very well, so novel porphyrin and related macrocycles with more desirable electronic properties are being synthesized and tested. At the same time, the quantum yield of triplet formation and of 1 O2 formation must be high, so many drug molecules can be activated and many oxidation reactions can occur during a short period of laser irradiation. Photodynamic therapy has been used successfully in the treatment of macular degeneration, a disease of the retina that leads to blindness, and in a number of cancers, including those of the lung, bladder, skin, and oesophagus. Checklist of key ideas 1. In a chain reaction, an intermediate (the chain carrier) produced in one step (the initiation step) attacks other reactant molecules (in the propagation steps), with each attack giving rise to a new carrier. The chain ends in the termination step. Examples of chain reactions include some explosions. 2. In stepwise polymerization any two monomers in the reaction mixture can link together at any time and growth of the polymer is not confined to chains that are already forming. The longer a stepwise polymerization proceeds, the higher the average molar mass of the product. 3. In chain polymerization an activated monomer attacks another monomer and links to it. That unit attacks another monomer, and so on. The slower the initiation of the chain, the higher the average molar mass of the polymer. 4. Catalysts are substances that accelerate reactions but undergo no net chemical change. 5. A homogeneous catalyst is a catalyst in the same phase as the reaction mixture. Enzymes are homogeneous, biological catalysts. 6. The Michaelis–Menten mechanism of enzyme kinetics accounts for the dependence of rate on the concentration of the substrate, v = vmax[S]0/([S]0 + KM). 7. A Lineweaver–Burk plot, based on 1/v = 1/vmax + (KM/vmax)(1/[S]0), is used to determine the parameters that occur in the Michaelis–Menten mechanism. 8. In competitive inhibition of an enzyme, the inhibitor binds only to the active site of the enzyme and thereby inhibits the attachment of the substrate. 9. In uncompetitive inhibition the inhibitor binds to a site of the enzyme that is removed from the active site, but only if the substrate is already present. 862 23 THE KINETICS OF COMPLEX REACTIONS Further reading Articles and texts J. Andraos, How mathematics figures in chemistry: some examples. J. Chem. Educ. 76, 258 (1999). C.E. Carraher, Jr., Seymour/Carraher’s polymer chemistry, Marcel Dekker (2000). A. Fersht, Structure and mechanism in protein science: a guide to enzyme catalysis and protein folding. W.H. Freeman, New York (1999). A.M. Kuznetsov and J. Ulstrup, Electron transfer in chemistry and biology: an introduction to the theory. Wiley, New York (1998). J.I. Steinfeld, J.S. Francisco, and W.L. Hase, Chemical kinetics and dynamics. Prentice Hall, Englewood Cliffs (1998). N.J. Turro, Modern molecular photochemistry. University Science Books, Sausalito (1991). K.E. van Holde, W.C. Johnson and P.H. Ho, Principles of physical biochemistry. Prentice Hall, Upper Saddle River (1998). D. Voet and J.G. Voet, Biochemistry. Wiley, New York (2004). Sources of data and information D.R. Lide (ed.), CRC handbook of chemistry and physics, Section 5. CRC Press, Boca Raton (2000). S.L. Murov, I. Carmichael, and G.L. Hug, Handbook of photochemistry. Marcel Dekker, New York (1993). NDRL/NIST solution kinetics database, NIST standard reference database 40, National Institute of Standards and Technology, Gaithersburg (1994). The URL is available on the web site for this book. NIST chemical kinetics database, NIST standard reference database 17, National Institute of Standards and Technology, Gaithersburg (1998). The URL is available on the web site for this book. Further information Further information 23.1 The Förster theory of resonance energy transfer From the qualitative description given in Section 23.7e, we conclude that resonance energy transfer arises from the interaction between two oscillating dipoles with moments µS and µQ. From Section 18.4, the energy of the dipole–dipole interaction, Vdipole–dipole, is Vdipole–dipole ∝ where R is the distance between the dipoles. We saw in Section 9.10 that the rate of a transition from a state i to a state f at a radiation frequency ν is proportional to the square modulus of the matrix element of the perturbation between the two states: wf←i ∝ |Hfi (1) |2 µSµQ R3 For energy transfer, the wavefunctions of the initial and final states may be denoted as ψS*ψQ and ψSψQ*, respectively, and H(1) may be written from Vdipole–dipole. It follows that the rate of energy transfer, wT, at a fixed distance R is given (using notation introduced in Further information 9.1) by wT ∝ ψSψQ* µSµQ ψS*ψQ 2 = ψS µS ψS* 2 ψQ* µQ ψQ 2 We have used the fact that the terms related to S are functions of coordinates that are independent of those for the functions related to Q. In the last expression, the integrals are squares of transition dipole moments at the radiation frequency ν, the first 1 R6 1 R6 10. In non-competitive inhibition, the inhibitor binds to a site other than the active site, and its presence reduces the ability of the substrate to bind to the active site. 11. The primary quantum yield of a photochemical reaction is the number of reactant molecules producing specified primary products for each photon absorbed; the overall quantum yield is the number of reactant molecules that react for each photon absorbed. 12. The observed fluorescence lifetime is related to the quantum yield, φf, and rate constant, kf, of fluorescence by τ0 = φf/kf. 13. A Stern–Volmer plot is used to analyse the kinetics of fluorescence quenching in solution. It is based on the Stern–Volmer equation, φf,0/φf = 1 + τ0kQ[Q]. 14. Collisional deactivation, electron transfer, and resonance energy transfer are common fluorescence quenching processes. The rate constants of electron and resonance energy transfer decrease with increasing separation between donor and acceptor molecules. 15. In photosensitization, the reaction of a molecule that does not absorb radiation directly is made to occur by energy transfer during a collision with a molecule that does absorb radiation. EXERCISES 863 Discussion questions 23.1 Identify any initiation, propagation, retardation, inhibition, and termination steps in the following chain mechanisms: (a) (1) AH → A· + H· (2) A· → B· + C (3) AH + B· → A· + D (4) A· + B· → P (b) (1) A2 → A· + A· (2) A· → B· + C (3) A· + P → B· (4) A· + B· → P 23.2 Bearing in mind distinctions between the mechanisms of stepwise and chain polymerization, describe ways in which it is possible to control the molar mass of a polymer by manipulating the kinetic parameters of polymerization. 23.3 Discuss the features, advantages, and limitations of the Michaelis–Menten mechanism of enzyme action. 23.4 Distinguish between competitive, non-competitive, and uncompetitive inhibition of enzymes. Discuss how these modes of inhibition may be detected experimentally. 23.5 Distinguish between the primary quantum yield and overall quantum yield of a chemical reaction. Describe an experimental procedure for the determination of the quantum yield. 23.6 Discuss experimental procedures that make it possible to differentiate between quenching by energy transfer, collisions, or electron transfer. 23.7 Summarize the main features of the Förster theory of resonance energy transfer. Then, discuss FRET in terms of Förster theory. ET = w0 = (kf + kIC + kISC)[S*] (23.40) where w0 is the rate of deactivation of S* in the absence of the quencher. The efficiency, ET, may be expressed in terms of the experimental fluorescence quantum yields ϕf,0 and ϕf of the donor in the absence and presence of the acceptor, respectively. To proceed, we use eqn 23.30 to write: φf,0 = and φf = where vf is the rate of fluorescence. Subsituting these results into eqn 23.40 gives, after a little algebra, eqn 23.37. Alternatively, we can express w0 in terms of the parameter R0, the characteristic distance at which wT = w0 for a specified pair of S and Q (Table 23.3). By using wT ∝ R−6 and w0 ∝ R0 −6 , we can rearrange the expression for ET into eqn 23.38. vf w0 + wT vf w0 wT wT + w0 corresponding to emission of S* to S and the second to absorption of Q to Q*. We interpret the expression for wT as follows. The rate of energy transfer is proportional to R−6 , so it decreases sharply with increasing separation between the energy donor and acceptor. Furthermore, the energy transfer rate is optimized when both emission of radiation by S* and absorption of radiation by Q are efficient at the frequency ν. Because the absorption and emission spectra of large molecules in condensed phases are broad, it follows that the energy transfer rate is optimal at radiation frequencies in which the emission spectrum of the donor and the absorption spectrum of the acceptor overlap significantly. In practice, it is more convenient to measure the efficiency of energy transfer and not the rate itself. In much the same way that we defined the quantum yield as a ratio of rates, we can also define the efficiency of energy transfer, ET, as the ratio Exercises In the following exercises and problems, it is recommended that rate constants are labelled with the number of the step in the proposed reaction mechanism, and any reverse steps are labelled similarly but with a prime. 23.1a Derive the rate law for the decomposition of ozone in the reaction 2 O3(g) → 3 O2(g) on the basis of the following proposed mechanism: (1) O3 5 O2 + O k1, k′1 (2) O + O3 → O2 + O2 k2 23.1b On the basis of the following proposed mechanism, account for the experimental fact that the rate law for the decomposition 2 N2O5(g) → 4 NO2(g) + O2(g) is v = k[N2O5]. (1) N2O5 5 NO2 + NO3 k1, k′1 (2) NO2 + NO3 → NO2 + O2 + NO k2 (3) NO + N2O5 → NO2 + NO2 + NO2 k3 23.2a A slightly different mechanism for the decomposition of N2O5 from that in Exercise 23.1b has also been proposed. It differs only in the last step, which is replaced by (3) NO + NO3 → NO2 + NO2 k3 Show that this mechanism leads to the same overall rate law. 23.2b Consider the following mechanism for the thermal decomposition of R2: (1) R2 → R + R (2) R + R2 → PB + R′ (3) R′ → PA + R (4) R + R → PA + PB where R2, PA, PB are stable hydrocarbons and R and R′ are radicals. Find the dependence of the rate of decomposition of R2 on the concentration of R2. 864 23 THE KINETICS OF COMPLEX REACTIONS Problems* Numerical problems 23.1 Studies of combustion reactions depend on knowing the concentrations of H atoms and HO radicals. Measurements on a flow system using EPR for the detection of radicals gave information on the reactions (1) H + NO2 → OH + NO k1 = 2.9 × 1010 dm3 mol−1 s−1 (2) OH + OH → H2O + O k2 = 1.55 × 109 dm3 mol−1 s−1 (3) O + OH → O2 + H k3 = 1.1 × 1010 dm3 mol−1 s−1 (J.N. Bradley, W. Hack, K. Hoyermann, and H.G. Wagner, J. Chem. Soc. Faraday Trans. I, 1889 (1973)). Using initial H atom and NO2 concentrations of 4.5 × 10−10 mol cm−3 and 5.6 × 10−10 mol cm−3 , respectively, compute and plot curves showing the O, O2, and OH concentrations as a function of time in the range 0–10 ns. 23.2 In a flow study of the reaction between O atoms and Cl2 (J.N. Bradley, D.A. Whytock, and T.A. Zaleski, J. Chem. Soc. Faraday Trans. I, 1251 (1973)) at high chlorine pressures, plots of ln [O]0/[O] against distances l along the flow tube, where [O]0 is the oxygen concentration at zero chlorine pressure, gave straight lines. Given the flow velocity as 6.66 m s−1 and the data below, find the rate coefficient for the reaction O + Cl2 → ClO + Cl. l/cm 0 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 ln([O]0/[O]) 0.27 0.31 0.34 0.38 0.45 0.46 0.50 0.55 0.56 0.60 with [O]0 = 3.3 10−8 mol dm−3 , [Cl2] = 2.54 × 10−7 mol dm−3 , p = 1.70 Torr. 23.3‡ J.D. Chapple-Sokol, C.J. Giunta, and R.G. Gordon (J. Electrochem. Soc. 136, 2993 (1989)) proposed the following radical chain mechanism for the initial stages of the gas-phase oxidation of silane by nitrous oxide: (1) N2O → N2 + O (2) O + SiH4 → SiH3 + OH (3) OH + SiH4 → SiH3 + H2O (4) SiH3 + N2O → SiH3O + N2 * Problems denoted with the symbol ‡ were supplied by Charles Trapp, Carmen Giunta, and Marshall Cady. 23.5b Consider the following chain mechanism: (1) A2 → A· + A· (2) A· → B· + C (3) A· + P → B· (4) A· + B· → P Use the steady-state approximation to deduce that the rate law for the consumption of A2. 23.6a The enzyme-catalysed conversion of a substrate at 25°C has a Michaelis constant of 0.035 mol dm−3 . The rate of the reaction is 1.15 × 10−3 mol dm−3 s−1 when the substrate concentration is 0.110 mol dm−3 . What is the maximum velocity of this enzymolysis? 23.6b The enzyme-catalysed conversion of a substrate at 25°C has a Michaelis constant of 0.042 mol dm−3 . The rate of the reaction is 2.45 × 10−4 mol dm−3 s−1 when the substrate concentration is 0.890 mol dm−3 . What is the maximum velocity of this enzymolysis? 23.7a In a photochemical reaction A → 2 B + C, the quantum efficiency with 500 nm light is 2.1 × 102 mol einstein−1 (1 einstein = 1 mol photons). After exposure of 300 mmol of A to the light, 2.28 mmol of B is formed. How many photons were absorbed by A? 23.7b In a photochemical reaction A → B + C, the quantum efficiency with 500 nm light is 1.2 × 102 mol einstein−1 . After exposure of 200 mmol A to the light, 1.77 mmol B is formed. How many photons were absorbed by A? 23.8a In an experiment to measure the quantum efficiency of a photochemical reaction, the absorbing substance was exposed to 490 nm light from a 100 W source for 45 min. The intensity of the transmitted light was 40 per cent of the intensity of the incident light. As a result of irradiation, 0.344 mol of the absorbing substance decomposed. Determine the quantum efficiency. 23.8b In an experiment to measure the quantum efficiency of a photochemical reaction, the absorbing substance was exposed to 320 nm radiation from a 87.5 W source for 28.0 min. The intensity of the transmitted light was 0.257 that of the incident light. As a result of irradiation, 0.324 mol of the absorbing substance decomposed. Determine the quantum efficiency. 23.3a Refer to Fig. 23.3 and determine the pressure range for a branching chain explosion in the hydrogen–oxygen reaction at 800 K. 23.3b Refer to Fig. 23.3 and determine the pressure range for a branching chain explosion in the hydrogen–oxygen reaction at (a) 700 K, (b) 900 K. 23.4a The condensation reaction of propanone, (CH3)2CO, in aqueous solution is catalysed by bases, B, which react reversibly with propanone to form the carbanion C3H5O− . The carbanion then reacts with a molecule of propanone to give the product. A simplified version of the mechanism is (1) AH + B → BH+ + A− (2) A− + BH+ → AH + B (3) A− + AH → product where AH stands for propanone and A− denotes its carbanion. Use the steadystate approximation to find the concentration of the carbanion and derive the rate equation for the formation of the product. 23.4b Consider the acid-catalysed reaction (1) HA + H+ 5 HAH+ k1k′1, both fast (2) HAH+ + B → BH+ + AH k2, slow Deduce the rate law and show that it can be made independent of the specific term [H+ ]. 23.5a Consider the following chain mechanism: (1) AH → A· + H· (2) A· → B· + C (3) AH + B· → A· + D (4) A· + B· → P Use the steady-state approximation to deduce that the decomposition of AH is first-order in AH. PROBLEMS 865 fluorescence intensity of an aqueous solution of dansyl chloride with time after excitation by a short laser pulse (with I0 the initial fluorescence intensity). t/ns 5.0 10.0 15.0 20.0 If/I0 0.45 0.21 0.11 0.05 (a) Calculate the observed fluorescence lifetime of dansyl chloride in water. (b) The fluorescence quantum yield of dansyl chloride in water is 0.70. What is the fluorescence rate constant? 23.8 When benzophenone is illuminated with ultraviolet light it is excited into a singlet state. This singlet changes rapidly into a triplet, which phosphoresces. Triethylamine acts as a quencher for the triplet. In an experiment in methanol as solvent, the phosphorescence intensity varied with amine concentration as shown below. A time-resolved laser spectroscopy experiment had also shown that the half-life of the fluorescence in the absence of quencher is 29 µs. What is the value of kq? [Q]/(mol dm−3 ) 0.0010 0.0050 0.0100 If/(arbitrary units) 0.41 0.25 0.16 23.9 An electronically excited state of Hg can be quenched by N2 according to Hg* (g) + N2 (g, v = 0) → Hg (g) + N2 (g, v = 1) in which energy transfer from Hg* excites N2 vibrationally. Fluorescence lifetime measurements of samples of Hg with and without N2 present are summarized below (T = 300 K): pN2 = 0.0 atm Relative fluorescence intensity 1.000 0.606 0.360 0.22 0.135 t/µs 0.0 5.0 10.0 15.0 20.0 pN2 = 9.74 × 10−4 atm Relative fluorescence intensity 1.000 0.585 0.342 0.200 0.117 t/µs 0.0 3.0 6.0 9.0 12.0 You may assume that all gases behave ideally. Determine the rate constant for the energy transfer process. 23.10 The Förster theory of resonance energy transfer and the basis for the FRET technique can be tested by performing fluorescence measurements on a series of compounds in which an energy donor and an energy acceptor are covalently linked by a rigid molecular linker of variable and known length. L. Stryer and R.P. Haugland (Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 58, 719 (1967)) collected the following data on a family of compounds with the general composition dansyl-(l-prolyl)n-naphthyl, in which the distance R between the naphthyl donor and the dansyl acceptor was varied from 1.2 nm to 4.6 nm by increasing the number of prolyl units in the linker: R/nm 1.2 1.5 1.8 2.8 3.1 3.4 3.7 4.0 4.3 4.6 1 − ET 0.99 0.94 0.97 0.82 0.74 0.65 0.40 0.28 0.24 0.16 Are the data described adequately by eqn 23.38? If so, what is the value of R0 for the naphthyl-dansyl pair? Theoretical problems 23.11 The Rice–Herzfeld mechanism for the dehydrogenation of ethane is specified in Section 23.1, and it was noted there that it led to first-order kinetics. Confirm this remark, and find the approximations that lead to the rate law quoted there. How may the conditions be changed so that the reaction shows different orders? 23.12 The following mechanism has been proposed for the thermal decomposition of acetaldehyde (ethanal): (1) CH3CHO → ·CH3 + CHO (2) ·CH3 + CH3CHO → CH4 + ·CH2CHO (3) ·CH2CHO → CO + ·CH3 (4) ·CH3 + ·CH3 → CH3CH3 (5) SiH3O + SiH4 → SiH3OH + SiH3 (6) SiH3 + SiH3O → (H3Si)2O Label each step with its role in the chain. Use the steady-state approximation to show that this mechanism predicts the following rate law for SiH4 consumption (provided k1 and k6 are in some sense small): = −k[N2O][SiH4]1/2 23.4‡ The water formation reaction has been studied many times and continues to be of interest. Despite the many studies there is not uniform agreement on the mechanism. But as explosions are known to occur at certain critical values of the pressure, any proposed mechanism to be considered plausible must be consistent with the existence of these critical explosion limits. One such plausible mechanism is that of Example 23.2. Another is the following: (1) H2 → H + H (2) H + O2 → OH + O (3) O + H2 → OH + H (4) H + O2 → HO2 (5) HO2 + H2 → H2O + OH (6) HO2 + wall → destruction (7) H + M → destruction In a manner similar to that in Example 23.2, determine whether or not this mechanism can lead to explosions under appropriate conditions. 23.5‡ For many years the reaction H2(g) + I2(g) → 2 HI(g) and its reverse were assumed to be elementary bimolecular reactions. However, J.H. Sullivan (J. Chem. Phys. 46, 73 (1967)) suggested that the following mechanism for the reaction, originally proposed by M. Bodenstein (Z. Physik. Chem. 29, 56 (1898)), provides a better explanation of the experimental results: (1) I2 5 I + I k1, k′1 (2) I + I + H2 → HI + HI k2 Obtain the expression for the rate of formation of HI based on this mechanism. Under what conditions does this rate law reduce to the one for the originally accepted mechanism? 23.6 The number of photons falling on a sample can be determined by a variety of methods, of which the classical one is chemical actinometry. The decomposition of oxalic acid (COOH)2, in the presence of uranyl sulfate, (UO2)SO4, proceeds according to the sequence (1) UO2+ + hν → (UO2+ )* (2) (UO2+ )* + (COOH)2 → UO2+ + H2O + CO2 + CO with a quantum efficiency of 0.53 at the wavelength used. The amount of oxalic acid remaining after exposure can be determined by titration (with KMnO4) and the extent of decomposition used to find the number of incident photons. In a particular experiment, the actinometry solution consisted of 5.232 g anhydrous oxalic acid, 25.0 cm3 water (together with the uranyl salt). After exposure for 300 s the remaining solution was titrated with 0.212 m KMnO4(aq), and 17.0 cm3 were required for complete oxidation of the remaining oxalic acid. The titration reaction is 2 MnO4 − (aq) + 5 (COOH)2(aq) + 6 H+ (aq) → 10 CO2(g) + 8 H2O(l) + 2 Mn2+ (aq) What is the rate of incidence of photons at the wavelength of the experiment? Express the answer in photons/second and einstein/second. 23.7 Dansyl chloride, which absorbs maximally at 330 nm and fluoresces maximally at 510 nm, can be used to label aminoacids in fluorescence microscopy and FRET studies. Tabulated below is the variation of the d[SiH4] dt Hence, show that rate measurements will give only a combination of k2 and k3 if a steady state is reached, but that both may be obtained if a steady state is not reached. 23.20 The photochemical chlorination of chloroform in the gas has been found to follow the rate law d[CCl4]/dt = k[Cl2]1/2 Ia 1/2 . Devise a mechanism that leads to this rate law when the chlorine pressure is high. 23.21 Photolysis of Cr(CO)6 in the presence of certain molecules M, can give rise to the following reaction sequence: (1) Cr(CO)6 + hν → Cr(CO)5 + CO (2) Cr(CO)5 + CO → Cr(CO)6 (3) Cr(CO)5 + M → Cr(CO)5M (4) Cr(CO)5M → Cr(CO)5 + M Suppose that the absorbed light intensity is so weak that I << k4[Cr(CO)5M]. Find the factor f in the equation d[Cr(CO)5M]/dt = −f [Cr(CO)5M]. Show that a graph of 1/f against [M] should be a straight line. Applications: to biochemistry and environmental science 23.22 Models of population growth are analogous to chemical reaction rate equations. In the model due to Malthus (1798) the rate of change of the population N of the planet is assumed to be given by dN/dt = births − deaths. The numbers of births and deaths are proportional to the population, with proportionality constants b and d. Obtain the integrated rate law. How well does it fit the (very approximate) data below on the population of the planet as a function of time? Year 1750 1825 1922 1960 1974 1987 2000 N/109 0.5 1 2 3 4 5 6 23.23 Many enzyme-catalysed reactions are consistent with a modified version of the Michaelis–Menten mechanism in which the second step is also reversible. (a) For this mechanism show that the rate of formation of product is given by v = where vmax = kb[E]0, v′max = ka′[E]0, KM = (ka′ + kb)/ka, and, and K′M = (k′a + kb)/kb′. (b) Find the limiting behaviour of this expression for large and small concentrations of substrate. 23.24 The following results were obtained for the action of an ATPase on ATP at 20°C, when the concentration of the ATPase was 20 nmol dm−3 : [ATP]/(µmol dm−3 ) 0.60 0.80 1.4 2.0 3.0 v/(µmol dm−3 s−1 ) 0.81 0.97 1.30 1.47 1.69 Determine the Michaelis constant, the maximum velocity of the reaction, the turnover number, and the catalytic efficiency of the enzyme. 23.25 Enzyme-catalysed reactions are sometimes analysed by use of the Eadie–Hofstee plot, in which v is plotted against v/[S]0. (a) Using the simple Michaelis–Menten mechanism, derive a relation between v/[S]0 and v. (b) Discuss how the values of KM and vmax are obtained from analysis of the Eadie–Hofstee plot. (c) Determine the Michaelis constant and the maximum velocity of the reaction of the reaction from Exercise 23.23 by using an Eadie–Hofstee plot to analyse the data. 23.26 In general, the catalytic efficiency of an enzyme depends on the pH of the medium in which it operates. One way to account for this behaviour is to propose that the enzyme and the enzyme–substrate complex are active only in specific protonation states. This situation can be summarized by the following mechanism: (vmax/KM)[S] − (v′max/K′M)[P] 1 + [S]/KM + [P]/K′M 866 23 THE KINETICS OF COMPLEX REACTIONS Find an expression for the rate of formation of methane and the rate of disappearance of acetaldehyde. 23.13 Express the root mean square deviation {͗M2 ͘ − ͗J͘2 }1/2 of the molar mass of a condensation polymer in terms of p, and deduce its time dependence. 23.14 Calculate the ratio of the mean cube molar mass to the mean square molar mass in terms of (a) the fraction p, (b) the chain length. 23.15 Calculate the average polymer length in a polymer produced by a chain mechanism in which termination occurs by a disproportionation reaction of the form M· + ·M → M + :M. 23.16 Derive an expression for the time dependence of the degree of polymerization for a stepwise polymerization in which the reaction is acidcatalysed by the -COOH acid functional group. The rate law is d[A]/dt = −k[A]2 [OH]. 23.17 Autocatalysis is the catalysis of a reaction by the products. For example, for a reaction A → P it may be found that the rate law is v = k[A][P] and the reaction rate is proportional to the concentration of P. The reaction gets started because there are usually other reaction routes for the formation of some P initially, which then takes part in the autocatalytic reaction proper. (a) Integrate the rate equation for an autocatalytic reaction of the form A → P, with rate law v = k[A][P], and show that = (b + 1) where a = ([A]0 + [P]0)k and b = [P]0/[A]0. Hint. Starting with the expression v = −d[A]/dt = k[A][P], write [A] = [A]0 − x, [P] = [P]0 + x and then write the expression for the rate of change of either species in terms of x. To integrate the resulting expression, the following relation will be useful: = + (b) Plot [P]/[P]0 against at for several values of b. Discuss the effect of autocatalysis on the shape of a plot of [P]/[P]0 against t by comparing your results with those for a first-order process, in which [P]/[P]0 = 1 − e−kt . (c) Show that, for the autocatalytic process discussed in parts (a) and (b), the reaction rate reaches a maximum at tmax = −(1/a) ln b. (d) An autocatalytic reaction A → P is observed to have the rate law d[P]/dt = k[A]2 [P]. Solve the rate law for initial concentrations [A]0 and [P]0. Calculate the time at which the rate reaches a maximum. (e) Another reaction with the stoichiometry A → P has the rate law d[P]/dt = k[A][P]2 ; integrate the rate law for initial concentrations [A]0 and [P]0. Calculate the time at which the rate reaches a maximum. 23.18 Conventional equilibrium considerations do not apply when a reaction is being driven by light absorption. Thus the steady-state concentration of products and reactants might differ significantly from equilibrium values. For instance, suppose the reaction A → B is driven by light absorption and that its rate is Ia, but that the reverse reaction B → A is bimolecular and second-order with a rate k[B]2 . What is the stationary state concentration of B? Why does this ‘photostationary state’ differ from the equilibrium state? 23.19 Derive an expression for the rate of disappearance of a species A in a photochemical reaction for which the mechanism is: (1) initiation with light of intensity I, A → R· + R· (2) propagation, A + R· → R· + B (3) termination, R· + R· → R2 D E F 1 [P]0 + x 1 [A]0 − x A B C 1 [A]0 + [P]0 1 ([A]0 − x)([P]0 + x) eat 1 + beat [P] [P]0 PROBLEMS 867 EH + S ⇔ ESH ka, ka′ ESH → E + P kb EH 5 E− + H+ KE,a = EH2 + 5 EH + H+ KE,b = ESH 5 ES− + H+ KES,a = ESH2 5 ESH + H+ KES,b = in which only the EH and ESH forms are active. (a) For the mechanism above, show that v = with v′max = 1 + + 1 + + K′M = KM 1 + + where vmax and KM correspond to the form EH of the enzyme. (b) For pH values ranging from 0 to 14, plot v′max against pH for a hypothetical reaction for which vmax = 1.0 × 10−6 mol dm−3 s−1 , KES,b = 1.0 × 10−6 mol dm−3 and KES,a = 1.0 × 10−8 mol dm−3 . Is there a pH at which v′max reaches a maximum value? If so, determine the pH. (c) Redraw the plot in part (b) by using the same value of vmax, but KES,b = 1.0 × 10−4 mol dm−3 and KES,a = 1.0 × 10−10 mol dm−3 . Account for any differences between this plot and the plot from part (b). 23.27 The enzyme carboxypeptidase catalyses the hydrolysis of polypeptides and here we consider its inhibition. The following results were obtained when the rate of the enzymolysis of carbobenzoxy-glycyl-D-phenylalanine (CBGP) was monitored without inhibitor: [CBGP]0/(10−2 mol dm−3 ) 1.25 3.84 5.81 7.13 Relative reaction rate 0.398 0.669 0.859 1.000 (All rates in this problem were measured with the same concentration of enzyme and are relative to the rate measured when [CBGP]0 = 0.0713 mol dm−3 in the absence of inhibitor.) When 2.0 × 10−3 mol dm−3 phenylbutyrate ion was added to a solution containing the enzyme and substrate, the following results were obtained: [CBGP]0/(10−2 mol dm−3 ) 1.25 2.50 4.00 5.50 Relative reaction rate 0.172 0.301 0.344 0.548 In a separate experiment, the effect of 5.0 × 10−2 mol dm−3 benzoate ion was monitored and the results were: [CBGP]0/(10−2 mol dm−3 ) 1.75 2.50 5.00 10.00 Relative reaction rate 0.183 0.201 0.231 0.246 Determine the mode of inhibition of carboxypeptidase by the phenylbutyrate ion and benzoate ion. 23.28 Many biological and biochemical processes involve autocatalytic steps (Problem 23.17). In the SIR model of the spread and decline of infectious diseases the population is divided into three classes; the susceptibles, S, who can catch the disease, the infectives, I, who have the disease and can transmit KES,a [H+ ] [H+ ] KES,b KE,a [H+ ] [H+ ] KE,b KES,a [H+ ] [H+ ] KES,b vmax v′max 1 + K′M[S]0 [ESH][H+ ] [ESH2] [ES− ][H+ ] [ESH] [EH][H+ ] [EH2 + ] [E− ][H+ ] [EH+ ] it, and the removed class, R, who have either had the disease and recovered, are dead, or are immune or isolated. The model mechanism for this process implies the following rate laws: = −rSI = rSI − aI = aI What are the autocatalytic steps of this mechanism? Find the conditions on the ratio a/r that decide whether the disease will spread (an epidemic) or die out. Show that a constant population is built into this system, namely, that S + I + R = N, meaning that the timescales of births, deaths by other causes, and migration are assumed large compared to that of the spread of the disease. 23.29 In light-harvesting complexes, the fluorescence of a chlorophyll molecule is quenched by nearby chlorophyll molecules. Given that for a pair of chlorophyll a molecules R0 = 5.6 nm, by what distance should two chlorophyll a molecules be separated to shorten the fluorescence lifetime from 1 ns (a typical value for monomeric chlorophyll a in organic solvents) to 10 ps? 23.30 The light-induced electron transfer reactions in photosynthesis occur because chlorophyll molecules (whether in monomeric or dimeric forms) are better reducing agents in their electronic excited states. Justify this observation with the help of molecular orbital theory. 23.31 The emission spectrum of a porphyrin dissolved in O2-saturated water shows a strong band at 650 nm and a weak band at 1270 nm. In separate experiments, it was observed that the electronic absorption spectrum of the porphyrin sample showed bands at 420 nm and 550 nm, and the electronic absorption spectrum of O2-saturated water showed no bands in the visible range of the spectrum (and therefore no emission spectrum when excited in the same range). Based on these data alone, make a preliminary assignment of the emission band at 1270 nm. Propose additional experiments that test your hypothesis. 23.32‡ Ultraviolet radiation photolyses O3 to O2 and O. Determine the rate at which ozone is consumed by 305 nm radiation in a layer of the stratosphere of thickness 1 km. The quantum efficiency is 0.94 at 220 K, the concentration about 8 × 10−9 mol dm−3 , the molar absorption coefficient 260 dm3 mol−1 cm−1 , and the flux of 305 nm radiation about 1 × 1014 photons cm−2 s−1 . Data from W.B. DeMore, S.P. Sander, D.M. Golden, R.F. Hampson, M.J. Kurylo, C.J. Howard, A.R. Ravishankara, C.E. Kolb, and M.J. Molina, Chemical kinetics and photochemical data for use in stratospheric modeling: Evaluation Number 11, JPL Publication 94–26 (1994). 23.33‡ Use the Chapman model to explore the behaviour of a model atmosphere consisting of pure O2 at 10 Torr and 298 K that is exposed to measurable frequencies and intensities of UV radiation. (a) Look up the values of k2, k4, and k5 in a source such as the CRC Handbook of chemistry and physics or Chemical kinetics and photochemical data for use in stratospheric modeling (the URL is available at the text’s web site). The rate constants k1 and k3 depend upon the radiation conditions; assume values of 1.0 × 10−8 s−1 and 0.016 s−1 , respectively. If you cannot find a value for k5, formulate chemically sound arguments for exclusion of the fifth step from the mechanism. (b) Write the rate expressions for the concentration of each chemical species. (c) Assume that the UV radiation is turned on at t = 0, and solve the rate expressions for the concentration of all species as a function of time over a period of 4 h. Examine relevant concentrations in the very early time period t < 0.1 s. State all assumptions. Is there any ozone present initially? Why must the pressure be low and the UV radiation intensities high for the production of ozone? Draw graphs of the time variations of both atomic oxygen and ozone on both the very short and the long timescales. What is the percentage of ozone after 4.0 h of irradiation? Hint. You will need a software package for solving a ‘stiff’ system of differential equations. Stiff differential equations have at least two rate constants with very different values and result in different behaviours on different timescales, so the solution usually requires that the total time period be broken into two or more periods; one may be dR dt dI dt dS dt 868 23 THE KINETICS OF COMPLEX REACTIONS very short and another very long. For help with using mathematical software to solve systems of differential equations, see M.P. Cady and C.A. Trapp, A Mathcad primer for physical chemistry. Oxford University Press (1999). 23.34‡ Chlorine atoms react rapidly with ozone in the gas-phase bimolecular reaction Cl + O3 → ClO + O2 with k = (1.7 × 1010 dm3 mol−1 s−1 )e−260/(T/K) (W.B. DeMore, S.P. Sander, D.M. Golden, R.F. Hampson, M.J. Kurylo, C.J. Howard, A.R. Ravishankara, C.E. Kolb, and M.J. Molina, Chemical kinetics and photochemical data for use in stratospheric modeling: Evaluation Number 11, JPL Publication 94–26 (1994)). Estimate the rate of this reaction at (a) 20 km, where [Cl] = 5 × 10−17 mol dm−3 , [O3] = 8 × 10−9 mol dm−3 , and T = 220 K; (b) 45 km, where [Cl] = 3 × 10−15 mol dm−3 , [O3] = 8 × 10−11 mol dm−3 , and T = 270 K. 23.35‡ Because of its importance in atmospheric chemistry, the thermal decomposition of nitric oxide, 2 NO(g) → N2(g) + O2(g), has been amongst the most thoroughly studied of gas-phase reactions. The commonly accepted mechanism has been that of H. Wise and M.F. Freech (J. Chem. Phys. 22, 1724 (1952)): (1) NO + NO → N2O + O k1 (2) O + NO → O2 + N k2 (3) N + NO → N2 + O k3 (4) O + O + M → O2 + M k4 (5) O2 + M → O + O + M k′4 (a) Label the steps of this mechanism as initiation, propagation, etc. (b) Write down the full expression for the rate of disappearance of NO. What does this expression for the rate become on the basis of the assumptions that v2 = v3 when [N] reaches its steady state concentration, that the rate of the propagation step is more rapid than the rate of the initiation step, and that oxygen atoms are in equilibrium with oxygen molecules? (c) Find an expression for the effective activation energy, Ea,eff, for the overall reaction in terms of the activation energies of the individual steps of the reaction. (d) Estimate Ea,eff from the bond energies of the species involved. (e) It has been pointed out by R.J. Wu and C.T. Yeh (Int. J. Chem. Kinet. 28, 89 (1996)) that the reported experimental values of Ea,eff obtained by different authors have varied from 253 to 357 kJ mol−1 . They suggest that the assumption of oxygen atoms and oxygen molecules being in equilibrium is unwarranted and that the steady-state approximation needs to be applied to the entire mechanism. Obtain the overall rate law based on the steady-state approximation and find the forms that it assumes for low NO conversion (low O2 concentration). (f) When the reaction conversion becomes significant, Wu and Yeh suggest that two additional elementary steps, (6) O2 + M → O + O + M k6 (7) NO + O2 → O + NO2 k7 start to compete with step (1) as the initiation step. Obtain the rate laws based on these alternative mechanisms and again estimate the apparent activation energies. Is the range of these different theoretically estimated values for Ea,eff consistent with the range of values obtained experimentally? Molecular reaction dynamics The simplest quantitative account of reaction rates is in terms of collision theory, which can be used only for the discussion of reactions between simple species in the gas phase. Reactions in solution are classified into two types: diffusion-controlled and activationcontrolled. The former can be expressed quantitatively in terms of the diffusion equation. In transition state theory, it is assumed that the reactant molecules form a complex that can be discussed in terms of the population of its energy levels. Transition state theory inspires a thermodynamic approach to reaction rates, in which the rate constant is expressed in terms of thermodynamic parameters. This approach is useful for parametrizing the rates of reactions in solution. The highest level of sophistication is in terms of potential energy surfaces and the motion of molecules through these surfaces. As we shall see, such an approach gives an intimate picture of the events that occur when reactions occur and is open to experimental study. We also use transition state theory to examine the transfer of electrons in homogeneous systems and see that the rate of the process depends on the distance between electron donor and acceptor, the standard Gibbs energy of reaction, and the energy associated with molecular rearrangements that accompany the transfer of charge. Now we are at the heart of chemistry. Here we examine the details of what happens to molecules at the climax of reactions. Extensive changes of structure are taking place and energies the size of dissociation energies are being redistributed among bonds: old bonds are being ripped apart and new bonds are being formed. As may be imagined, the calculation of the rates of such processes from first principles is very difficult. Nevertheless, like so many intricate problems, the broad features can be established quite simply. Only when we enquire more deeply do the complications emerge. In this chapter we look at several approaches to the calculation of a rate constant for elementary bimolecular processes, ranging from electron transfer to chemical reactions involving bond breakage and formation. Although a great deal of information can be obtained from gas-phase reactions, many reactions of interest take place in solution, and we shall also see to what extent their rates can be predicted. Reactive encounters In this section we consider two elementary approaches to the calculation of reaction rates, one relating to gas-phase reactions and the other to reactions in solution. Both approaches are based on the view that reactant molecules must meet, and that reaction takes place only if the molecules have a certain minimum energy. In the collision theory of bimolecular gas-phase reactions, which we mentioned briefly in Section 22.5, 24 Reactive encounters 24.1 Collision theory 24.2 Diffusion-controlled reactions 24.3 The material balance equation Transition state theory 24.4 The Eyring equation 24.5 Thermodynamic aspects The dynamics of molecular collisions 24.6 Reactive collisions 24.7 Potential energy surfaces 24.8 Some results from experiments and calculations 24.9 The investigation of reaction dynamics with ultrafast laser techniques Electron transfer in homogeneous systems 24.10 The rates of electron transfer processes 24.11 Theory of electron transfer processes 24.12 Experimental results I24.1 Impact on biochemistry: Electron transfer in and between proteins Checklist of key ideas Further reading Further information 24.1: The Gibbs energy of activation of electron transfer and the Marcus cross- relation Discussion questions Exercises Problems 870 24 MOLECULAR REACTION DYNAMICS products are formed only if the collision is sufficiently energetic; otherwise the colliding reactant molecules separate again. In solution, the reactant molecules may simply diffuse together and then acquire energy from their immediate surroundings while they are in contact. 24.1 Collision theory We shall consider the bimolecular elementary reaction A + B → P v = k2[A][B] (24.1) where P denotes products, and aim to calculate the second-order rate constant k2. We can anticipate the general form of the expression for k2 by considering the physical requirements for reaction. We expect the rate v to be proportional to the rate of collisions, and therefore to the mean speed of the molecules, K ∝ (T/M)1/2 where M is the molar mass of the molecules, their collision cross-section, σ, and the number densities N A and N B of A and B: v ∝ σ(T/M)1/2 N AN B ∝ σ(T/M)1/2 [A][B] However, a collision will be successful only if the kinetic energy exceeds a minimum value, the activation energy, Ea, of the reaction. This requirement suggests that the rate constant should also be proportional to a Boltzmann factor of the form e−Ea/RT . So we can anticipate, by writing the reaction rate in the form given in eqn 24.1, that k2 ∝ σ(T/M)1/2 e−Ea /RT Not every collision will lead to reaction even if the energy requirement is satisfied, because the reactants may need to collide in a certain relative orientation. This ‘steric requirement’ suggests that a further factor, P, should be introduced, and that k2 ∝ Pσ(T/M)1/2 e−Ea/RT (24.2) As we shall see in detail below, this expression has the form predicted by collision theory. It reflects three aspects of a successful collision: k2 ∝ steric requirement × encounter rate × minimum energy requirement (a) Collision rates in gases We have anticipated that the reaction rate, and hence k2, depends on the frequency with which molecules collide. The collision density, ZAB, is the number of (A,B) collisions in a region of the sample in an interval of time divided by the volume of the region and the duration of the interval. The frequency of collisions of a single molecule in a gas was calculated in Section 21.1. As shown in the Justification below, that result can be adapted to deduce that ZAB = σ 1/2 N2 A[A][B] (24.3a) where σ is the collision cross-section (Fig. 24.1) σ = πd2 d = 1 –2(dA + dB) (24.3b) and µ is the reduced mass, µ = (24.3c) mAmB mA + mB D F 8kT πµ A C Area A B dA dB d s Fig. 24.1 The collision cross-section for two molecules can be regarded to be the area within which the projectile molecule (A) must enter around the target molecule (B) in order for a collision to occur. If the diameters of the two molecules are dA and dB, the radius of the target area is d = 1 –2(dA + dB) and the cross-section is πd2 . 24.1 COLLISION THEORY 871 Similarly, the collision density for like molecules at a molar concentration [A] is ZAA = σ 1/2 N2 A[A]2 (24.4) Collision densities may be very large. For example, in nitrogen at room temperature and pressure, with d = 280 pm, Z = 5 × 1034 m−3 s−1 . Justification 24.1 The collision density It follows from eqn 21.11 that the collision frequency, z, for a single A molecule of mass mA in a gas of other A molecules is z = σKrelN A (24.5) where N A is the number density of A molecules and Krel is their relative mean speed. As indicated in Section 21.1a, Krel = 21/2 K K = 1/2 (24.6) For future convenience, it is sensible to introduce µ = 1–2m (for like molecules of mass m), and then to write Krel = 1/2 (24.7) This expression also applies to the mean relative speed of dissimilar molecules, provided that µ is interpreted as the reduced mass in eqn 24.5. The total collision density is the collision frequency multiplied by the number density of A molecules: ZAA = 1–2zN A = 1–2σKrelN A 2 (24.8) The factor of 1–2 has been introduced to avoid double counting of the collisions (so one A molecule colliding with another A molecule is counted as one collision regardless of their actual identities). For collisions of A and B molecules present at number densities N A and N B, the collision density is ZAB = σKrelN AN B (24.9) Note that we have discarded the factor of 1–2 because now we are considering an A molecule colliding with any of the B molecules as a collision. The number density of a species J is N J = NA[J], where [J] is their molar concentration and NA is Avogadro’s constant. Equations 24.3 and 24.4 then follow. (b) The energy requirement According to collision theory, the rate of change in the molar concentration of A molecules is the product of the collision density and the probability that a collision occurs with sufficient energy. The latter condition can be incorporated by writing the collision cross-section as a function of the kinetic energy of approach of the two colliding species, and setting the cross-section, σ(ε), equal to zero if the kinetic energy of approach is below a certain threshold value, εa. Later, we shall identify NAεa as Ea, the (molar) activation energy of the reaction. Then, for a collision with a specific relative speed of approach vrel (not, at this stage, a mean value), = −σ(ε)vrelNA[A][B] (24.10) d[A] dt D E F 8kT πµ A B C D E F 8kT πm A B C D F 4kT πmA A C Comment 24.1 See Further information 10.1. The kinetic energy associated with the relative motion of two particles takes the form ε = 1–2µv2 rel when the centre-of-mass coordinates are separated from the internal coordinates of each particle. 872 24 MOLECULAR REACTION DYNAMICS The relative kinetic energy, ε, and the relative speed are related by ε = 1 –2µv2 rel, so vrel = (2εµ)1/2 . At this point we recognize that a wide range of approach energies is present in a sample, so we should average the expression just derived over a Boltzmann distribution of energies f(ε), and write (see Comment 24.2) = − Ύ ∞ 0 σ(ε)vrel f(ε)dε NA[A][B] (24.11) and hence recognize the rate constant as k2 = NAΎ ∞ 0 σ(ε)vrel f(ε)dε (24.12) Now suppose that the reactive collision cross-section is zero below εa. We show in the Justification below that, above εa, σ(ε) varies as σ(ε) = 1 − σ (24.13) This form of the energy dependence is broadly consistent with experimental determinations of the reaction between H and D2 as determined by molecular beam measurements of the kind described later (Fig. 24.2). Then, in the Justification below, we show that k2 = NAσKrele−Ea/RT (24.14) Justification 24.2 The rate constant Consider two colliding molecules A and B with relative speed vrel and relative kinetic energy ε = 1–2µv2 rel (Fig. 24.3). Intuitively we expect that a head-on collision between A and B will be most effective in bringing about a chemical reaction. Therefore, vrel,A–B, the magnitude of the relative velocity component parallel to an axis that contains the vector connecting the centres of A and B, must be large. From trigonometry and the definitions of the distances a and d, and the angle θ given in Fig. 24.3, it follows that vrel,A–B = vrel cos θ = vrel 1/2 (24.15) We assume that only the kinetic energy associated with the head-on component of the collision, εA–B, can lead to a chemical reaction. After squaring both sides of the equation above and multiplying by 1–2µ, it follows that εA–B = ε (24.16) The existence of an energy threshold, εa, for the formation of products implies that there is a maximum value of a, amax, above which reactions do not occur. Setting a = amax and εA–B = εa in the equation above gives a2 max = 1 − d2 (24.17) Substitution of σ(ε) for πa2 max and σ for πd2 in the equation above gives eqn 24.13. Note that the equation can be used only when ε > εa. We proceed with the calculation of the rate constant by considering the Maxwell– Boltzmann distribution of molecular speeds given in Section 21.1. It may be expressed D E F εa ε A B C d2 − a2 d2 D E F d2 − a2 d2 A B C D F εa ε A C 5 6 7 1 2 3 d[A] dt Comment 24.2 To go from eqn 24.10 to eqn 24.11, we need to review concepts of probability theory summarized in Appendix 2. Namely, the mean value of a continuous variable X is given by ͗X͘ = ∫xf(x)dx where the integral is over all values x that X can assume and the probability of finding a value of X between x and x + dx is f(x)dx, with f(x) a measure of the distribution of the probability values over x. The mean value of a function g(X) is given by ͗g(X)͘ = ∫g(x)f(x)dx s()/E 0 5 10 15 E E/ a 0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1 1.2 1.0 10 pm 0.90 eV ´ 4 2 1.7 10 pm 1.95 eV ´ 4 2 ss d a B vrel,A B- vrel q A Fig. 24.3 The parameters used in the calculation of the dependence of the collision cross-section on the relative kinetic energy of two molecules A and B. Fig. 24.2 The variation of the reactive crosssection with energy as expressed by eqn 24.13. The data points are from experiments on the reaction H + D2 → HD + D (K. Tsukiyama, B. Katz, and R. Bersohn, J. Chem. Phys. 84, 1934 (1986)). 24.1 COLLISION THEORY 873 in terms of the kinetic energy, ε, by writing ε = 1–2µv2 , then dv = dε/(2µε)1/2 and eqn 21.4 becomes f(v)dv = 4π 3/2 e−ε/kT = 2π 3/2 ε1/2 e−ε/kT dε = f(ε)dε (24.18) The integral we need to evaluate is therefore Ύ ∞ 0 σ(ε)vrel f(ε)dε = 2π 3/2 Ύ ∞ 0 σ(ε) 1/2 ε1/2 e−ε/kT dε = 1/2 Ύ ∞ 0 εσ(ε)e−ε/kT dε To proceed, we introduce the approximation for σ(ε) in eqn 24.13, and evaluate Ύ ∞ 0 εσ(ε)e−ε/kT dε = σΎ ∞ εa ε 1 − e−ε/kT dε = (kT)2 σe−εa/kT We have made use of the fact that σ = 0 for ε < εa. It follows that Ύ ∞ 0 σ(ε)vrel f(ε)dε = σ 1/2 e−εa/kT as in eqn 24.14 (with εa/kT = Ea/RT). Equation 24.14 has the Arrhenius form k2 = Ae−Ea/RT provided the exponential temperature dependence dominates the weak square-root temperature dependence of the pre-exponential factor. It follows that we can identify the activation energy, Ea, with the minimum kinetic energy along the line of approach that is needed for reaction, and that the pre-exponential factor is a measure of the rate at which collisions occur in the gas. (c) The steric requirement The simplest procedure for calculating k2 is to use for σ the values obtained for nonreactive collisions (for example, typically those obtained from viscosity measurements) or from tables of molecular radii. Table 24.1 compares some values of the pre-exponential factor calculated in this way with values obtained from Arrhenius plots (Section 22.5a). One of the reactions shows fair agreement between theory and D E F 8kT πµ A B C D E F εa ε A B C D E F 1 kT A B C D E F 8 πµkT A B C D E F 2ε µ A B C D E F 1 πkT A B C D E F 1 πkT A B C dε (2µε)1/2 D E F 2ε µ A B C D E F µ 2πkT A B C Synoptic table 24.1* Arrhenius parameters for gas-phase reactions A/(dm3 mol−1 s−1 ) Experiment Theory Ea/(kJ mol−1 ) P 2 NOCl → 2 NO + 2 Cl 9.4 × 109 5.9 × 1010 102 0.16 2 ClO → Cl2 + O2 6.3 × 107 2.5 × 1010 0 2.5 × 10−3 H2 + C2H4 → C2H6 1.24 × 106 7.4 × 1011 180 1.7 × 10−6 K + Br2 → KBr + Br 1.0 × 1012 2.1 × 1011 0 4.8 * More values are given in the Data section. 874 24 MOLECULAR REACTION DYNAMICS Area *s Area Products Deflected reactant molecule s s Fig. 24.4 The collision cross-section is the target area that results in simple deflection of the projectile molecule; the reaction cross-section is the corresponding area for chemical change to occur on collision. experiment, but for others there are major discrepancies. In some cases the experimental values are orders of magnitude smaller than those calculated, which suggests that the collision energy is not the only criterion for reaction and that some other feature, such as the relative orientation of the colliding species, is important. Moreover, one reaction in the table has a pre-exponential factor larger than theory, which seems to indicate that the reaction occurs more quickly than the particles collide! We can accommodate the disagreement between experiment and theory by introducing a steric factor, P, and expressing the reactive cross-section, σ*, as a multiple of the collision cross-section, σ* = Pσ (Fig. 24.4). Then the rate constant becomes k2 = Pσ 1/2 NAe−Ea/RT (24.19) This expression has the form we anticipated in eqn 24.2. The steric factor is normally found to be several orders of magnitude smaller than 1. Example 24.1 Estimating a steric factor (1) Estimate the steric factor for the reaction H2 + C2H4 → C2H6 at 628 K given that the pre-exponential factor is 1.24 × 106 dm3 mol−1 s−1 . Method To calculate P, we need to calculate the pre-exponential factor, A, by using eqn 24.19 and then compare the answer with experiment: the ratio is P. Table 21.1 lists collision cross-sections for non-reactive encounters. The best way to estimate the collision cross-section for dissimilar spherical species is to calculate the collision diameter for each one (from σ = πd2 ), to calculate the mean of the two diameters, and then to calculate the cross-section for that mean diameter. However, as neither species is spherical, a simpler but more approximate procedure is just to take the average of the two collision cross-sections. Answer The reduced mass of the colliding pair is µ = = 3.12 × 10−27 kg because m1 = 2.016 u for H2 and m2 = 28.05 u for C2H4 (the atomic mass unit, 1 u, is defined inside the front cover). Hence 1/2 = 2.66 × 103 m s−1 From Table 21.1, σ(H2) = 0.27 nm2 and σ(C2H4) = 0.64 nm2 , giving a mean collision cross-section of σ = 0.46 nm2 . Therefore, A = σ 1/2 NA = 7.37 × 1011 dm3 mol−1 s−1 Experimentally A = 1.24 × 106 dm3 mol−1 s−1 , so it follows that P = 1.7 × 10−6 . The very small value of P is one reason why catalysts are needed to bring this reaction about at a reasonable rate. As a general guide, the more complex the molecules, the smaller the value of P. Self-test 24.1 It is found for the reaction NO + Cl2 → NOCl + Cl that A = 4.0 × 109 dm3 mol−1 s−1 at 298 K. Use σ(NO) = 0.42 nm2 and σ(Cl2) = 0.93 nm2 to estimate the P factor for the reaction. [0.018] D F 8kT πµ A C D F 8kT πµ A C m1m2 m1 + m2 D F 8kT πµ A C 24.1 COLLISION THEORY 875 An example of a reaction for which it is possible to estimate the steric factor is K + Br2 → KBr + Br, with the experimental value P = 4.8. In this reaction, the distance of approach at which reaction occurs appears to be considerably larger than the distance needed for deflection of the path of the approaching molecules in a non-reactive collision. It has been proposed that the reaction proceeds by a harpoon mechanism. This brilliant name is based on a model of the reaction that pictures the K atom as approaching a Br2 molecule, and when the two are close enough an electron (the harpoon) flips across from K to Br2. In place of two neutral particles there are now two ions, so there is a Coulombic attraction between them: this attraction is the line on the harpoon. Under its influence the ions move together (the line is wound in), the reaction takes place, and KBr + Br emerge. The harpoon extends the cross-section for the reactive encounter, and the reaction rate is greatly underestimated by taking for the collision cross-section the value for simple mechanical contact between K + Br2. Example 24.2 Estimating a steric factor (2) Estimate the value of P for the harpoon mechanism by calculating the distance at which it becomes energetically favourable for the electron to leap from K to Br2. Method We should begin by identifying all the contributions to the energy of interaction between the colliding species. There are three contributions to the energy of the process K + Br2 → K+ + Br2 − . The first is the ionization energy, I, of K. The second is the electron affinity, Eea, of Br2. The third is the Coulombic interaction energy between the ions when they have been formed: when their separation is R, this energy is −e2 /4πε0R. The electron flips across when the sum of these three contributions changes from positive to negative (that is, when the sum is zero). Answer The net change in energy when the transfer occurs at a separation R is E = I − Eea − The ionization energy I is larger than Eea, so E becomes negative only when R has decreased to less than some critical value R* given by = I − Eea When the particles are at this separation, the harpoon shoots across from K to Br2, so we can identify the reactive cross-section as σ* = πR*2 . This value of σ* implies that the steric factor is P = = = 2 where d = R(K) + R(Br2). With I = 420 kJ mol−1 (corresponding to 7.0 × 10−19 J), Eea ≈ 250 kJ mol−1 (corresponding to 4.2 × 10−19 J), and d = 400 pm, we find P = 4.2, in good agreement with the experimental value (4.8). Self-test 24.2 Estimate the value of P for the harpoon reaction between Na and Cl2 for which d ≈ 350 pm; take Eea ≈ 230 kJ mol−1 . [2.2] Example 24.2 illustrates two points about steric factors. First, the concept of a steric factor is not wholly useless because in some cases its numerical value can be estimated. 5 6 7 e2 4πε0d(I − Eea) 1 2 3 R*2 d2 σ* σ e2 4πε0R* e2 4πε0R 876 24 MOLECULAR REACTION DYNAMICS Second (and more pessimistically) most reactions are much more complex than K + Br2, and we cannot expect to obtain P so easily. What we need is a more powerful theory that lets us calculate, and not merely guess, its value. We go some way to setting up that theory in Section 24.4. 24.2 Diffusion-controlled reactions Encounters between reactants in solution occur in a very different manner from encounters in gases. Reactant molecules have to jostle their way through the solvent, so their encounter frequency is considerably less than in a gas. However, because a molecule also migrates only slowly away from a location, two reactant molecules that encounter each other stay near each other for much longer than in a gas. This lingering of one molecule near another on account of the hindering presence of solvent molecules is called the cage effect. Such an encounter pair may accumulate enough energy to react even though it does not have enough energy to do so when it first forms. The activation energy of a reaction is a much more complicated quantity in solution than in a gas because the encounter pair is surrounded by solvent and we need to consider the energy of the entire local assembly of reactant and solvent molecules. (a) Classes of reaction The complicated overall process can be divided into simpler parts by setting up a simple kinetic scheme. We suppose that the rate of formation of an encounter pair AB is first-order in each of the reactants A and B: A + B → AB v = kd[A][B] (24.20a) As we shall see, kd (where the d signifies diffusion) is determined by the diffusional characteristics of A and B. The encounter pair can break up without reaction or it can go on to form products P. If we suppose that both processes are pseudofirst-order reactions (with the solvent perhaps playing a role), then we can write AB → A + B v = kd′[AB] (24.20b) and AB → P v = ka[AB] (24.20c) The concentration of AB can now be found from the equation for the net rate of change of concentration of AB: = kd[A][B] − kd′[AB] − ka[AB] ≈ 0 (24.21) where we have applied the steady-state approximation. This expression solves to [AB] = (24.22) The rate of formation of products is therefore ≈ ka[AB] = k2[A][B] k2 = (24.23) Two limits can now be distinguished. If the rate of separation of the unreacted encounter pair is much slower than the rate at which it forms products, then k′d << ka and the effective rate constant is kakd ka + k′d d[P] dt kd[A][B] ka + k′d d[AB] dt 24.2 DIFFUSION-CONTROLLED REACTIONS 877 k2 ≈ = kd (24.24) In this diffusion-controlled limit, the rate of reaction is governed by the rate at which the reactant molecules diffuse through the solvent. An indication that a reaction is diffusion-controlled is that its rate constant is of the order of 109 dm3 mol−1 s−1 or greater. Because the combination of radicals involves very little activation energy, radical and atom recombination reactions are often diffusion-controlled. An activation-controlled reaction arises when a substantial activation energy is involved in the reaction AB → P. Then ka << kd′ and k2 ≈ = kaK (24.25) where K is the equilibrium constant for A + B 5 AB. In this limit, the reaction proceeds at the rate at which energy accumulates in the encounter pair from the surrounding solvent. Some experimental data are given in Table 24.2. (b) Diffusion and reaction The rate of a diffusion-controlled reaction is calculated by considering the rate at which the reactants diffuse together. As shown in the Justification below, the rate constant for a reaction in which the two reactant molecules react if they come within a distance R* of one another is kd = 4πR*DNA (24.26) where D is the sum of the diffusion coefficients the two reactant species in the solution. Justification 24.3 Solution of the radial diffusion equation From the form of the diffusion equation (Section 21.10) corresponding to motion in three dimensions, DB∇2 [B] = ∂[B]/∂t, the concentration of B when the system has reached a steady state (∂[B]/∂t = 0) satisfies ∇2 [B]r = 0, where the subscript r signifies a quantity that varies with the distance r. For a spherically symmetrical system, ∇2 can be replaced by radial derivatives alone (see Table 8.1), so the equation satisfied by [B]r is + = 0 (24.27) The general solution of this equation is [B]r = a + (24.28) b r d[B]r dr 2 r d2 [B]r dr2 kakd k′d kakd ka Synoptic table 24.2* Arrhenius parameters for reactions in solution Solvent A/(dm3 mol−1 s−1 ) Ea/(kJ mol−1 ) (CH3)3CCl solvolysis Water 7.1 × 1016 100 Ethanol 3.0 × 1013 112 Chloroform 1.4 × 104 45 CH3CH2Br Ethanol 4.3 × 1011 90 * More values are given in the Data section. 878 24 MOLECULAR REACTION DYNAMICS as may be verified by substitution. We need two boundary conditions to pin down the values of the two constants. One condition is that [B]r has its bulk value [B] as r → ∞. The second condition is that the concentration of B is zero at r = R*, the distance at which reaction occurs. It follows that a = [B] and b = −R*[B], and hence that (for r ≥ R*) [B]r = 1 + [B] (24.29) Figure 24.5 illustrates the variation of concentration expressed by this equation. The rate of reaction is the (molar) flux, J, of the reactant B towards A multiplied by the area of the spherical surface of radius R*: Rate of reaction = 4πR*2 J (24.30) From Fick’s first law (eqn 21.17), the flux towards A is proportional to the concentration gradient, so at a radius R*: J = DB r=R* = (24.31) (A sign change has been introduced because we are interested in the flux towards decreasing values of r.) When this condition is substituted into the previous equation we obtain Rate of reaction = 4πR*DB[B] (24.32) The rate of the diffusion-controlled reaction is equal to the average flow of B molecules to all the A molecules in the sample. If the bulk concentration of A is [A], the number of A molecules in the sample of volume V is NA[A]V; the global flow of all B to all A is therefore 4πR*DBNA[A][B]V. Because it is unrealistic to suppose that all A are stationary; we replace DB by the sum of the diffusion coefficients of the two species and write D = DA + DB. Then the rate of change of concentration of AB is = 4πR*DNA[A][B] (24.33) Hence, the diffusion-controlled rate constant is as given in eqn 24.26. We can take eqn 24.26 further by incorporating the Stokes–Einstein equation (eqn 21.66) relating the diffusion constant and the hydrodynamic radius RA and RB of each molecule in a medium of viscosity η: DA = DB = (24.34) As these relations are approximate, little extra error is introduced if we write RA = RB = 1 –2R*, which leads to kd = (24.35) (The R in this equation is the gas constant.) The radii have cancelled because, although the diffusion constants are smaller when the radii are large, the reactive collision radius is larger and the particles need travel a shorter distance to meet. In this approximation, the rate constant is independent of the identities of the reactants, and depends only on the temperature and the viscosity of the solvent. 8RT 3η kT 6πηRB kT 6πηRA d[AB] dt DB[B] R* D E F d[B]r dr A B C D E F R* r A B C 0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1 MolarconcentrationofB,[B]/[B]r 0 2 4 6 8 10 r R/ * R* Fig. 24.5 The concentration profile for reaction in solution when a molecule B diffuses towards another reactant molecule and reacts if it reaches R*. 24.3 THE MATERIAL BALANCE EQUATION 879 Illustration 24.1 Estimating a diffusional rate constant The rate constant for the recombination of I atoms in hexane at 298 K, when the viscosity of the solvent is 0.326 cP (with 1 P = 10−1 kg m−1 s−1 ) is kd = = 2.0 × 107 m3 mol−1 s−1 where we have used 1 J = 1 kg m2 s−2 . Because 1 m3 = 103 dm3 , this result corresponds to 2.0 × 1010 dm3 mol−1 s−1 . The experimental value is 1.3 × 1010 dm3 mol−1 s−1 , so the agreement is very good considering the approximations involved. 24.3 The material balance equation The diffusion of reactants plays an important role in many chemical processes, such as the diffusion of O2 molecules into red blood corpuscles and the diffusion of a gas towards a catalyst. We can have a glimpse of the kinds of calculations involved by considering the diffusion equation (Section 21.10) generalized to take into account the possibility that the diffusing, convecting molecules are also reacting. (a) The formulation of the equation Considerasmallvolumeelementinachemicalreactor(orabiologicalcell).Thenetrate at which J molecules enter the region by diffusion and convection is given by eqn 21.71: = D − v (24.36) The net rate of change of molar concentration due to chemical reaction is = −k[J] (24.37) if we suppose that J disappears by a pseudofirst-order reaction. Therefore, the overall rate of change of the concentration of J is = D − v − k[J] (24.38) Spread due to Change Loss non-uniform due to due to concentration convection reaction Equation 24.38 is called the material balance equation. If the rate constant is large, then [J] will decline rapidly. However, if the diffusion constant is large, then the decline can be replenished as J diffuses rapidly into the region. The convection term, which may represent the effects of stirring, can sweep material either into or out of the region according to the signs of v and the concentration gradient ∂[J]/∂x. (b) Solutions of the equation The material balance equation is a second-order partial differential equation and is far from easy to solve in general. Some idea of how it is solved can be obtained by considering the special case in which there is no convective motion (as in an unstirred reaction vessel): = D − k[J] (24.39) ∂2 [J] ∂x2 ∂[J] ∂t ! @ 1 2 3 1 2 3 ∂[J] ∂x ∂2 [J] ∂x2 ∂[J] ∂t ∂[J] ∂t ∂[J] ∂x ∂2 [J] ∂x2 ∂[J] ∂t 8 × (8.3145 J K−1 mol−1 ) × (298 K) 3 × (3.26 × 10−4 kg m−1 s−1 ) 880 24 MOLECULAR REACTION DYNAMICS As may be verified by susbtitution, if the solution of this equation in the absence of reaction (that is, for k = 0) is [J], then the solution in the presence of reaction (k > 0) is [J]* = k Ύ t 0 [J]e−kt dt + [J]e−kt (24.40) We have already met one solution of the diffusion equation in the absence of reaction: eqn 21.71 is the solution for a system in which initially a layer of n0NA molecules is spread over a plane of area A: [J] = (24.41) When this expression is substituted into eqn 24.40 and the integral is evaluated numerically, we obtain the concentration of J as it diffuses away from its initial surface layer and undergoes reaction in the solution above (Fig. 24.6). Even this relatively simple example has led to an equation that is difficult to solve, and only in some special cases can the full material balance equation be solved analytically. Most modern work on reactor design and cell kinetics uses numerical methods to solve the equation, and detailed solutions for realistic environments, such as vessels ofdifferentshapes(whichinfluencetheboundaryconditionsonthesolutions)andwith a variety of inhomogeneously distributed reactants can be obtained reasonably easily. Transition state theory We saw in Section 22.5b that an activated complex forms between reactants as they collide and begin to assume the nuclear and electronic configurations characteristic of products. We also saw that the change in potential energy associated with formation of the activated complex accounts for the activation energy of the reaction. We now consider a more detailed calculation of rate constants which uses the concepts of statistical thermodynamics developed in Chapter 17. The approach we describe, which is called transition state theory (also widely referred to as activated complex theory), has the advantage that a quantity corresponding to the steric factor appears automatically, and P does not need to be grafted on to an equation as an afterthought. Transition state theory is an attempt to identify the principal features governing the size of a rate constant in terms of a model of the events that take place during the reaction. There are several approaches to the calculation, all of which lead to the same final expression (see Further reading); here we present the simplest approach. 24.4 The Eyring equation Transition state theory pictures a reaction between A and B as proceeding through the formation of an activated complex, C‡ , in a rapid pre-equilibrium (Fig. 24.7): A + B 5 C‡ K‡ = (24.42) When we express the partial pressures, pJ, in terms of the molar concentrations, [J], by using pJ = RT[J], the concentration of activated complex is related to the (dimensionless) equilibrium constant by [C‡ ] = K‡ [A][B] (24.43) RT p7 pC‡p7 pApB n0e−x2 /4Dt A(πDt)1/2 Dt = 0.05 Dt = 0.10 Distance from plane, x Concentrationofreactant,[J] Fig. 24.6 The concentration profiles for a diffusing, reacting system (for example, a column of solution) in which one reactant is initially in a layer at x = 0. In the absence of reaction (grey lines) the concentration profiles are the same as in Fig. 21.26. Exploration Use the interactive applet found in the Living graphs section of the text’s web site to explore the effect of varying the value of the rate constant k on the spatial variation of [J] for a constant value of the diffusion constant D. Comment 24.3 This chapter inevitably puts heavy demands on the letter K; the various meanings are summarized in Table 24.3 at the end of the chapter. 24.4 THE EYRING EQUATION 881 The activated complex falls apart by unimolecular decay into products, P, with a rate constant k‡ : C‡ → P v = k‡ [C‡ ] (24.44) It follows that v = k2[A][B] k2 = k‡ K‡ (24.45) Our task is to calculate the unimolecular rate constant k‡ and the equilibrium constant K‡ . (a) The rate of decay of the activated complex An activated complex can form products if it passes through the transition state, the arrangement the atoms must achieve in order to convert to products (Section 22.5b). If its vibration-like motion along the reaction coordinate occurs with a frequency ν, then the frequency with which the cluster of atoms forming the complex approaches the transition state is also ν. However, it is possible that not every oscillation along the reaction coordinate takes the complex through the transition state. For instance, the centrifugal effect of rotations might also be an important contribution to the breakup of the complex, and in some cases the complex might be rotating too slowly, or rotating rapidly but about the wrong axis. Therefore, we suppose that the rate of passage of the complex through the transition state is proportional to the vibrational frequency along the reaction coordinate, and write k‡ = κν (24.46) where κ is the transmissioncoefficient. In the absence of information to the contrary, κ is assumed to be about 1. (b) The concentration of the activated complex We saw in Section 17.8 how to calculate equilibrium constants from structural data. Equation 17.54 of that section can be used directly, which in this case gives K‡ = e−∆E0/RT (24.47) where p7 = 1 bar and ∆E0 = E0(C‡ ) − E0(A) − E0(B) (24.48) The qJ 7 are the standard molar partition functions, as defined in Section 17.1. Note that the units of NA and the qJ are mol−1 , so K‡ is dimensionless (as is appropriate for an equilibrium constant). In the final step of this part of the calculation, we focus attention on the partition function of the activated complex. We have already assumed that a vibration of the activated complex C‡ tips it through the transition state. The partition function for this vibration is q = (24.49a) where ν is its frequency (the same frequency that determines k‡ ). This frequency is much lower than for an ordinary molecular vibration because the oscillation corresponds to the complex falling apart (Fig. 24.8), so the force constant is very low. 1 1 − e−hν/kT NAq7 C‡ q7 Aq7 B RT p7 Activated complex Transition state Reactants Products Reaction coordinate Potentialenergy Fig. 24.7 A reaction profile. The horizontal axis is the reaction coordinate, and the vertical axis is potential energy. The activated complex is the region near the potential maximum, and the transition state corresponds to the maximum itself. Fig. 24.8 In an elementary depiction of the activated complex close to the transition state, there is a broad, shallow dip in the potential energy surface along the reaction coordinate. The complex vibrates harmonically and almost classically in this well. However, this depiction is an oversimplification, for in many cases there is no dip at the top of the barrier, and the curvature of the potential energy, and therefore the force constant, is negative. Formally, the vibrational frequency is then imaginary. We ignore this problem here, but see Further reading. 882 24 MOLECULAR REACTION DYNAMICS Therefore, provided that hν/kT << 1, the exponential may be expanded and the partition function reduces to q = ≈ (24.49b) 1 − 1 − + · · · We can therefore write qC‡ ≈ ’C‡ (24.50) where ’ denotes the partition function for all the other modes of the complex. The constant K‡ is therefore K‡ = I‡ I‡ = e−∆E0/RT (24.51) with I‡ a kind of equilibrium constant, but with one vibrational mode of C‡ discarded. (c) The rate constant We can now combine all the parts of the calculation into k2 = k‡ K‡ = κν I‡ (24.52) At this stage the unknown frequencies ν cancel and, after writing I‡ c = (RT/p7 )I‡ , we obtain the Eyring equation: k2 =κ I‡ c (24.53) The factor I‡ c is given by eqn 24.51 and the definition I‡ c = (RT/p7 )I‡ in terms of the partition functions of A, B, and C‡ , so in principle we now have an explicit expression for calculating the second-order rate constant for a bimolecular reaction in terms of the molecular parameters for the reactants and the activated complex and the quantity κ. The partition functions for the reactants can normally be calculated quite readily, using either spectroscopic information about their energy levels or the approximate expressions set out in Table 17.3. The difficulty with the Eyring equation, however, lies in the calculation of the partition function of the activated complex: C‡ is difficult to investigate spectroscopically (but see Section 24.9), and in general we need to make assumptions about its size, shape, and structure. We shall illustrate what is involved in one simple but significant case. (d) The collision of structureless particles Consider the case of two structureless particles A and B colliding to give an activated complex that resembles a diatomic molecule. Because the reactants J = A, B are structureless ‘atoms’, the only contributions to their partition functions are the translational terms: q7 J = ΛJ = V7 m = (24.54) The activated complex is a diatomic cluster of mass mC = mA + mB and moment of inertia I. It has one vibrational mode, but that mode corresponds to motion along the RT p7 h (2πmJkT)1/2 V7 m Λ3 J kT h RT p7 kT hν RT p7 NA’7 C‡ q7 Aq7 B kT hν kT hν D E F hν kT A B C kT hν 1 24.5 THERMODYNAMIC ASPECTS 883 reaction coordinate and therefore does not appear in ’C‡. It follows that the standard molar partition function of the activated complex is q7 C‡ = (24.55) The moment of inertia of a diatomic molecule of bond length r is µr2 , where µ = mAmB/(mA + mB) is the effective mass, so the expression for the rate constant is k2 = κ e−∆E0/RT = κ NA e−∆E0/RT = κNA 1/2 πr2 e−∆E0/RT (24.56) Finally, by identifying κπr2 as the reactive cross-section σ*, we arrive at precisely the same expression as that obtained from simple collision theory (eqn 24.14). 24.5 Thermodynamic aspects The statistical thermodynamic version of transition state theory rapidly runs into difficulties because only in some cases is anything known about the structure of the activated complex. However, the concepts that it introduces, principally that of an equilibrium between the reactants and the activated complex, have motivated a more general, empirical approach in which the activation process is expressed in terms of thermodynamic functions. (a) Activation parameters If we accept that I‡ is an equilibrium constant (despite one mode of C‡ having been discarded), we can express it in terms of a Gibbs energy of activation, ∆‡ G, through the definition ∆‡ G = −RT ln I‡ [24.57] (All the ∆‡ X in this section are standard thermodynamic quantities, ∆‡ X7 , but we shall omit the standard state sign to avoid overburdening the notation). Then the rate constant becomes k2 = κ e−∆‡ G/RT (24.58) Because G = H − TS, the Gibbs energy of activation can be divided into an entropy of activation, ∆‡ S, and an enthalpy of activation, ∆‡ H, by writing ∆‡ G = ∆‡ H − T∆‡ S [24.59] When eqn 24.59 is used in eqn 24.58 and κ is absorbed into the entropy term, we obtain k2 = Be∆‡ S/R e−∆‡ H/RT B = (24.60) The formal definition of activation energy, Ea = RT2 (∂ ln k/∂T), then gives Ea = ∆‡ H + 2RT, so k2 = e2 Be∆‡ S/R e−Ea/RT (24.61) RT p7 kT h RT p7 kT h D F 8kT πµ A C D F 2IkT $2 A C D F ΛAΛB ΛC‡ A C kT h D F 2IkT $2 A C D F NAΛ3 AΛ3 B Λ3 C‡V7 m A C RT p7 kT h V7 m Λ3 C‡ D F 2IkT $2 A C Comment 24.4 For reactions of the type A + B 5 P in the gas phase, Ea = ∆‡ H + 2RT. For these reactions in solution, Ea = ∆‡ H + RT. 884 24 MOLECULAR REACTION DYNAMICS from which it follows that the Arrhenius factor A can be identified as A = e2 Be∆‡ S/R (24.62) The entropy of activation is negative because two reactant species come together to form one species. However, if there is a reduction in entropy below what would be expected for the simple encounter of A and B, then A will be smaller than that expected on the basis of simple collision theory. Indeed, we can identify that additional reduction in entropy, ∆‡ Ssteric, as the origin of the steric factor of collision theory, and write P = e∆‡ Ssteric/R (24.63) Thus, the more complex the steric requirements of the encounter, the more negative the value of ∆‡ Ssteric, and the smaller the value of P. Gibbs energies, enthalpies, entropies, volumes, and heat capacities of activation are widely used to report experimental reaction rates, especially for organic reactions in solution. They are encountered when relationships between equilibrium constants and rates of reaction are explored using correlation analysis, in which ln K (which is equal to −∆rG7 /RT) is plotted against ln k (which is proportional to −∆‡ G/RT). In many cases the correlation is linear, signifying that, as the reaction becomes thermodynamically more favourable, its rate constant increases (Fig. 24.9). This linear correlation is the origin of the alternative name linear free energy relation (LFER; see Further reading). (b) Reactions between ions The thermodynamic version of transition state theory simplifies the discussion of reactions in solution. The statistical thermodynamic theory is very complicated to apply because the solvent plays a role in the activated complex. In the thermodynamic approach we combine the rate law = k‡ [C‡ ] (24.64) with the thermodynamic equilibrium constant K = = Kγ Kγ = (24.65) Then = k2[A][B] k2 = (24.66) If k°2 is the rate constant when the activity coefficients are 1 (that is, k°2 = k‡ K), we can write k2 = (24.67) At low concentrations the activity coefficients can be expressed in terms of the ionic strength, I, of the solution by using the Debye–Hückel limiting law (Section 5.9, particularly eqn 5.69) in the form log γJ = −AzJ 2 I1/2 (24.68) with A = 0.509 in aqueous solution at 298 K. Then log k2 = log k°2 − A{z2 A + z2 B − (zA + zB)2 }I1/2 = log k°2 + 2AzAzBI1/2 (24.69) k°2 Kγ k‡ K Kγ d[P] dt γC‡ γAγB [C‡ ] [A][B] aC‡ aAaB d[P] dt Reaction coordinate Gibbsenergy D ‡ G(B) D ‡ G(A) DrG°(B) DrG°(A) Fig. 24.9 For a related series of reactions, as the magnitude of the standard reaction Gibbs energy increases, so the activation barrier decreases. The approximate linear correlation between ∆‡ G and ∆rG7 is the origin of linear free energy relations. 24.5 THERMODYNAMIC ASPECTS 885 -0.4 -0.2 0.2 0.4 0.6 log(/°)kk 0 0.1 0.2 I1/2 2+ 2+ 2+ 2+ 2+ + + + + + - -2- 0 -or Fig. 24.10 Experimental tests of the kinetic salt effect for reactions in water at 298 K. The ion types are shown as spheres, and the slopes of the lines are those given by the Debye–Hückel limiting law and eqn 24.69. 0 0.1 0.2 0 -0.1 -0.2 -0.3 log(/°)kk I1/2 Fig. 24.11 The experimental ionic strength dependence of the rate constant of a hydrolysis reaction: the slope gives information about the charge types involved in the activated complex of the rate-determining step. See Example 24.3. The charge numbers of A and B are zA and zB, so the charge number of the activated complex is zA + zB; the zJ are positive for cations and negative for anions. Equation 24.69 expresses the kinetic salt effect, the variation of the rate constant of a reaction between ions with the ionic strength of the solution (Fig. 24.10). If the reactant ions have the same sign (as in a reaction between cations or between anions), then increasing the ionic strength by the addition of inert ions increases the rate constant. The formation of a single, highly charged ionic complex from two less highly charged ions is favoured by a high ionic strength because the new ion has a denser ionic atmosphere and interacts with that atmosphere more strongly. Conversely, ions of opposite charge react more slowly in solutions of high ionic strength. Now the charges cancel and the complex has a less favourable interaction with its atmosphere than the separated ions. Example 24.3 Analysing the kinetic salt effect The rate constant for the base hydrolysis of [CoBr(NH3)5]2+ varies with ionic strength as tabulated below. What can be deduced about the charge of the activated complex in the rate-determining stage? I 0.0050 0.0100 0.0150 0.0200 0.0250 0.0300 k/k° 0.718 0.631 0.562 0.515 0.475 0.447 Method According to eqn 24.69, plot log(k/k°) against I1/2 , when the slope will give 1.02zAzB, from which we can infer the charges of the ions involved in the formation of the activated complex. Answer Form the following table: I 0.0050 0.0100 0.0150 0.0200 0.0250 0.0300 I1/2 0.071 0.100 0.122 0.141 0.158 0.173 log(k/k°) −0.14 −0.20 −0.25 −0.29 −0.32 −0.35 These points are plotted in Fig. 24.11. The slope of the (least squares) straight line is −2.04, indicating that zAzB = −2. Because zA = −1 for the OH− ion, if that ion is involved in the formation of the activated complex, then the charge number of the second ion is +2. This analysis suggests that the pentaamminebromocobalt(III) cation participates in the formation of the activated complex. The rate constant is also influenced by the relative permittivity of the medium. Self-test 24.3 An ion of charge number +1 is known to be involved in the activated complex of a reaction. Deduce the charge number of the other ion from the following data: I 0.0050 0.010 0.015 0.020 0.025 0.030 k/k° 0.930 0.902 0.884 0.867 0.853 0.841 [−1] The dynamics of molecular collisions We now come to the third and most detailed level of our examination of the factors that govern the rates of reactions. 886 24 MOLECULAR REACTION DYNAMICS 24.6 Reactive collisions Molecular beams allow us to study collisions between molecules in preselected energy states, and can be used to determine the states of the products of a reactive collision. Information of this kind is essential if a full picture of the reaction is to be built, because the rate constant is an average over events in which reactants in different initial states evolve into products in their final states. (a) Experimental probes of reactive collisions Detailed experimental information about the intimate processes that occur during reactive encounters comes from molecular beams, especially crossed molecular beams (Fig. 24.12). The detector for the products of the collision of two beams can be moved to different angles, so the angular distribution of the products can be determined. Because the molecules in the incoming beams can be prepared with different energies (for example, with different translational energies by using rotating sectors and supersonic nozzles, with different vibrational energies by using selective excitation with lasers, as shown in Section 24.9b, and with different orientations (by using electric fields), it is possible to study the dependence of the success of collisions on these variables and to study how they affect the properties of the outcoming product molecules. One method for examining the energy distribution in the products is infrared chemiluminescence, in which vibrationally excited molecules emit infrared radiation as they return to their ground states. By studying the intensities of the infrared emission spectrum, the populations of the vibrational states may be determined (Fig. 24.13). Another method makes use of laser-induced fluorescence. In this technique, a laser is used to excite a product molecule from a specific vibration-rotation level; the intensity of the fluorescence from the upper state is monitored and interpreted in terms of the population of the initial vibration-rotation state. When the molecules being studied do not fluoresce efficiently, coherent anti-Stokes Raman spectroscopy (CARS, Section 13.16) can be used to monitor the progress of reaction. Multiphoton ionization (MPI) techniques are also good alternatives for the study of weakly fluorescing molecules. In MPI, the absorption of several photons by a molecule results in ionization if the total photon energy is greater than the ionization energy of the molecule. One or more pulsed lasers are used to generate the molecular ions, which are commonly detected by time-of-flight mass spectrometry (TOF-MS, Section 19.2). The angular distribution of products can also be determined by reaction product imaging. In this technique, product ions are accelerated by an electric field towards a phosphorescent screen and the light emitted from specific spots where the ions struck the screen is imaged by a charge-coupled device (CCD, Further information 13.1). An important variant of MPI is resonant multiphoton ionization (REMPI), in which one or more photons promote a molecule to an electronically excited state and then additional photons are used to generate ions from the excited state. The power of REMPI lies in the fact that the experimenter can choose which reactant or product to study by tuning the laser frequency to the electronic absorption band of a specific molecule. (b) State-to-state dynamics The concept of collision cross-section was introduced in connection with collision theory in Section 24.1, where we saw that the second-order rate constant, k2, can be expressed as a Boltzmann-weighted average of the reactive collision cross-section and the relative speed of approach. We shall write eqn 24.12 as k2 = ͗σvrel͘NA (24.70) Source 1 Source 2 Detector Fig. 24.12 In a crossed-beam experiment, state-selected molecules are generated in two separate sources, and are directed perpendicular to one another. The detector responds to molecules (which may be product molecules if chemical reaction occurs) scattered into a chosen direction. 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 v Fig. 24.13 Infrared chemiluminescence from CO produced in the reaction O + CS → CO + S arises from the non-equilibrium populations of the vibrational states of CO and the radiative relaxation to equilibrium. 24.7 POTENTIAL ENERGY SURFACES 887 where the angle brackets denote a Boltzmann average. Molecular beam studies provide a more sophisticated version of this quantity, for they provide the state-to-state cross-section, σnn′, and hence the state-to-state rate constant, knn′: knn′ = ͗σnn′vrel͘NA (24.71) The rate constant k2 is the sum of the state-to-state rate constant over all final states (because a reaction is successful whatever the final state of the products) and over a Boltzmann-weighted sum of initial states (because the reactants are initially present with a characteristic distribution of populations at a temperature T): k2 = ∑ n,n′ knn′(T)fn(T) (24.72) where fn(T) is the Boltzmann factor at a temperature T. It follows that, if we can determine or calculate the state-to-state cross-sections for a wide range of approach speeds and initial and final states, then we have a route to the calculation of the rate constant for the reaction. 24.7 Potential energy surfaces One of the most important concepts for discussing beam results and calculating the state-to-state collision cross-section is the potential energy surface of a reaction, the potential energy as a function of the relative positions of all the atoms taking part in the reaction. Potential energy surfaces may be constructed from experimental data, with the techniques described in Section 24.6, and from results of quantum chemical calculations (Section 11.7). The theoretical method requires the systematic calculation of the energies of the system in a large number of geometrical arrangements. Special computational techniques are used to take into account electron correlation, which arises from instantaneous interactions between electrons as they move closer to and farther from each other in molecule or molecular cluster. Techniques that incorporate electron correlation are very time-consuming and, consequently, only reactions between relatively small particles, such as the reactions H + H2 → H2 + H and H + H2O → OH + H2, are amenable to this type of theoretical treatment. An alternative is to use semi-empirical methods, in which results of calculations and experimental parameters are used to construct the potential energy surface. To illustrate the features of a potential energy surface we consider the collision between an H atom and an H2 molecule. Detailed calculations show that the approach of an atom along the H-H axis requires less energy for reaction than any other approach, so initially we confine our attention to a collinear approach. Two parameters are required to define the nuclear separations: one is the HA-HB separation RAB, and the other is the HB-HC separation RBC. At the start of the encounter RAB is infinite and RBC is the H2 equilibrium bond length. At the end of a successful reactive encounter RAB is equal to the equilibrium bond length and RBC is infinite. The total energy of the three-atom system depends on their relative separations, and can be found by doing a molecular orbital calculation. The plot of the total energy of the system against RAB and RBC gives the potential energy surface of this collinear reaction (Fig. 24.14). This surface is normally depicted as a contour diagram (Fig. 24.15). When RAB is very large, the variations in potential energy represented by the surface as RBC changes are those of an isolated H2 molecule as its bond length is altered. A section through the surface at RAB = ∞, for example, is the same as the H2 bonding potential energy curve drawn in Fig. 11.16. At the edge of the diagram where RBC is very large, a section through the surface is the molecular potential energy curve of an isolated HAHB molecule. Potential energy RBC RAB Re Re RBC RAB 0 Fig. 24.14 The potential energy surface for the H + H2 → H2 + H reaction when the atoms are constrained to be collinear. Fig. 24.15 The contour diagram (with contours of equal potential energy) corresponding to the surface in Fig. 24.14. Re marks the equilibrium bond length of an H2 molecule (strictly, it relates to the arrangement when the third atom is at infinity). 888 24 MOLECULAR REACTION DYNAMICS The actual path of the atoms in the course of the encounter depends on their total energy, the sum of their kinetic and potential energies. However, we can obtain an initial idea of the paths available to the system for paths that correspond to least potential energy. For example, consider the changes in potential energy as HA approaches HBHC. If the HB-HC bond length is constant during the initial approach of HA, then the potential energy of the H3 cluster rises along the path marked A in Fig. 24.16. We see that the potential energy reaches a high value as HA is pushed into the molecule and then decreases sharply as HC breaks off and separates to a great distance. An alternative reaction path can be imagined (B) in which the HB-HC bond length increases while HA is still far away. Both paths, although feasible if the molecules have sufficient initial kinetic energy, take the three atoms to regions of high potential energy in the course of the encounter. The path of least potential energy is the one marked C, corresponding to RBC lengthening as HA approaches and begins to form a bond with HB. The HB-HC bond relaxes at the demand of the incoming atom, and the potential energy climbs only as far as the saddle-shaped region of the surface, to the saddle point marked C‡ . The encounter of least potential energy is one in which the atoms take route C up the floor of the valley, through the saddle point, and down the floor of the other valley as HC recedes and the new HA-HB bond achieves its equilibrium length. This path is the reaction coordinate we met in Section 24.4. We can now make contact with the transition state theory of reaction rates. In terms of trajectories on potential surfaces, the transition state can be identified with a critical geometry such that every trajectory that goes through this geometry goes on to react (Fig. 24.17). 24.8 Some results from experiments and calculations To travel successfully from reactants to products the incoming molecules must possess enough kinetic energy to be able to climb to the saddle point of the potential surface. Therefore, the shape of the surface can be explored experimentally by changing the relative speed of approach (by selecting the beam velocity) and the degree of vibrational excitation and observing whether reaction occurs and whether the products emerge in a vibrationally excited state (Fig. 24.18). For example, one question that can be answered is whether it is better to smash the reactants together with a lot of translational kinetic energy or to ensure instead that they approach in highly excited vibrational states. Thus, is trajectory C2*, where the HBHC molecule is initially vibrationally excited, more efficient at leading to reaction than the trajectory C1*, in which the total energy is the same but has a high translational kinetic energy? (a) The direction of attack and separation Figure 24.19 shows the results of a calculation of the potential energy as an H atom approaches an H2 molecule from different angles, the H2 bond being allowed to relax to the optimum length in each case. The potential barrier is least for collinear attack, as we assumed earlier. (But we must be aware that other lines of attack are feasible and contribute to the overall rate.) In contrast, Fig. 24.20 shows the potential energy changes that occur as a Cl atom approaches an HI molecule. The lowest barrier occurs for approaches within a cone of half-angle 30° surrounding the H atom. The relevance of this result to the calculation of the steric factor of collision theory should be noted: not every collision is successful, because not every one lies within the reactive cone. If the collision is sticky, so that when the reactants collide they orbit around each other, the products can be expected to emerge in random directions because all RBC RAB 0 B A C C ‡ Fig. 24.16 Various trajectories through the potential energy surface shown in Fig. 24.15. Path A corresponds to a route in which RBC is held constant as HA approaches; path B corresponds to a route in which RBC lengthens at an early stage during the approach of HA; path C is the route along the floor of the potential valley. Potential energy RAB RBC Fig. 24.17 The transition state is a set of configurations (here, marked by the line across the saddle point) through which successful reactive trajectories must pass. 24.8 SOME RESULTS FROM EXPERIMENTS AND CALCULATIONS 889 memory of the approach direction has been lost. A rotation takes about 1 ps, so if the collision is over in less than that time the complex will not have had time to rotate and the products will be thrown off in a specific direction. In the collision of K and I2, for example, most of the products are thrown off in the forward direction. This product distribution is consistent with the harpoon mechanism (Section 24.1c) because the transition takes place at long range. In contrast, the collision of K with CH3I leads to reaction only if the molecules approach each other very closely. In this mechanism, K effectively bumps into a brick wall, and the KI product bounces out in the backward direction. The detection of this anisotropy in the angular distribution of products gives an indication of the distance and orientation of approach needed for reaction, as well as showing that the event is complete in less than 1 ps. (b) Attractive and repulsive surfaces Some reactions are very sensitive to whether the energy has been predigested into a vibrational mode or left as the relative translational kinetic energy of the colliding molecules. For example, if two HI molecules are hurled together with more than twice the activation energy of the reaction, then no reaction occurs if all the energy is translational. For F + HCl → Cl + HF, for example, the reaction is about five times as efficient when the HCl is in its first vibrational excited state than when, although HCl has the same total energy, it is in its vibrational ground state. RBC RBC RAB RAB 0 0 C1 * (a) (b) C2 * C3 C4 (c) (d) Fig. 24.18 Some successful (*) and unsuccessful encounters. (a) C1* corresponds to the path along the foot of the valley. (b) C2* corresponds to an approach of A to a vibrating BC molecule, and the formation of a vibrating AB molecule as C departs. (c) C3 corresponds to A approaching a non-vibrating BC molecule, but with insufficient translational kinetic energy. (d) C4 corresponds to A approaching a vibrating BC molecule, but still the energy, and the phase of the vibration, is insufficient for reaction. H H H H Unsuccessful attack Successful attack I H Cl Fig. 24.20 The potential energy barrier for the approach of Cl to HI. In this case, successful encounters occur only when Cl approaches within a cone surrounding the H atom. Fig. 24.19 An indication of the anisotropy of the potential energy changes as H approaches H2 with different angles of attack. The collinear attack has the lowest potential barrier to reaction. The surface indicates the potential energy profile along the reaction coordinate for each configuration. Comment 24.5 In molecular beam work the remarks we make in our discussion normally refer to directions in a centre-of-mass coordinate system. The origin of the coordinates is the centre of mass of the colliding reactants, and the collision takes place when the molecules are at the origin. The way in which centre-of-mass coordinates are constructed and the events in them interpreted involves too much detail for our present purposes, but we should bear in mind that ‘forward’ and ‘backward’ have unconventional meanings. The details are explained in the books in Further reading. 890 24 MOLECULAR REACTION DYNAMICS The origin of these requirements can be found by examining the potential energy surface. Figure 24.21 shows an attractive surface in which the saddle point occurs early in the reaction coordinate. Figure 24.22 shows a repulsive surface in which the saddle point occurs late. A surface that is attractive in one direction is repulsive in the reverse direction. Consider first the attractive surface. If the original molecule is vibrationally excited, then a collision with an incoming molecule takes the system along C. This path is bottled up in the region of the reactants, and does not take the system to the saddle point. If, however, the same amount of energy is present solely as translational kinetic energy, then the system moves along C* and travels smoothly over the saddle point into products. We can therefore conclude that reactions with attractive potential energy surfaces proceed more efficiently if the energy is in relative translational motion. Moreover, the potential surface shows that once past the saddle point the trajectory runs up the steep wall of the product valley, and then rolls from side to side as it falls to the foot of the valley as the products separate. In other words, the products emerge in a vibrationally excited state. Now consider the repulsive surface (Fig. 24.22). On trajectory C the collisional energy is largely in translation. As the reactants approach, the potential energy rises. Their path takes them up the opposing face of the valley, and they are reflected back into the reactant region. This path corresponds to an unsuccessful encounter, even though the energy is sufficient for reaction. On C* some of the energy is in the vibration of the reactant molecule and the motion causes the trajectory to weave from side to side up the valley as it approaches the saddle point. This motion may be sufficient to tip the system round the corner to the saddle point and then on to products. In this case, the product molecule is expected to be in an unexcited vibrational state. Reactions with repulsive potential surfaces can therefore be expected to proceed more efficiently if the excess energy is present as vibrations. This is the case with the H + Cl2 → HCl + Cl reaction, for instance. (c) Classical trajectories A clear picture of the reaction event can be obtained by using classical mechanics to calculate the trajectories of the atoms taking place in a reaction from a set of initial conditions, such as velocities, relative orientations, and internal energies of the reacting C* ‡ C C* C Fig. 24.21 An attractive potential energy surface. A successful encounter (C*) involves high translational kinetic energy and results in a vibrationally excited product. Fig. 24.22 A repulsive potential energy surface. A successful encounter (C*) involves initial vibrational excitation and the products have high translational kinetic energy. A reaction that is attractive in one direction is repulsive in the reverse direction. 24.8 SOME RESULTS FROM EXPERIMENTS AND CALCULATIONS 891 particles. The initial values used for the internal energy reflect the quantization of electronic, vibrational, and rotational energies in molecules but the features of quantum mechanics are not used explicitly in the calculation of the trajectory. Figure 24.23 shows the result of such a calculation of the positions of the three atoms in the reaction H + H2 → H2 + H, the horizontal coordinate now being time and the vertical coordinate the separations. This illustration shows clearly the vibration of the original molecule and the approach of the attacking atom. The reaction itself, the switch of partners, takes place very rapidly and is an example of a direct mode process. The newly formed molecule shakes, but quickly settles down to steady, harmonic vibration as the expelled atom departs. In contrast, Fig. 24.24 shows an example of a complex mode process, in which the activated complex survives for an extended period. The reaction in the illustration is the exchange reaction KCl + NaBr → KBr + NaCl. The tetratomic activated complex survives for about 5 ps, during which time the atoms make about 15 oscillations before dissociating into products. (d) Quantum mechanical scattering theory Classical trajectory calculations do not recognize the fact that the motion of atoms, electrons, and nuclei is governed by quantum mechanics. The concept of trajectory then fades and is replaced by the unfolding of a wavefunction that represents initially the reactants and finally products. Complete quantum mechanical calculations of trajectories and rate constants are very onerous because it is necessary to take into account all the allowed electronic, vibrational, and rotational states populated by each atom and molecule in the system at a given temperature. It is common to define a ‘channel’ as a group of molecules in well-defined quantum mechanically allowed states. Then, at a given temperature, there are many channels that represent the reactants and many channels that represent possible products, with some transitions between channels being allowed but others not allowed. Furthermore, not every transition leads to a chemical reaction. For example, the process H2* + OH → H2 + (OH)*, where the asterisk denotes an excited state, amounts to energy transfer between H2 and OH, whereas the process H2* + OH → H2O + H represents a chemical reaction. What complicates a quantum mechanical calculation of trajectories and rate constants even in this simple four-atom system is that many reacting channels present at a given temperature can lead to the desired products H2O + H, which themselves may be formed as many distinct channels. The cumulative reaction probability, N(E), at a fixed total energy E is then written as N(E) = ∑ i,j Pij(E) (24.73) 0 200 400 Internucleardistance,/pmR 0 10 20 30 40 Time, /fst RAB RBC Fig. 24.23 The calculated trajectories for a reactive encounter between A and a vibrating BC molecule leading to the formation of a vibrating AB molecule. This direct-mode reaction is between H and H2. (M. Karplus, R.N. Porter, and R.D. Sharma, J. Chem. Phys., 43, 3258 (1965).) Time, /pst 0 2.5 5 7.5 500 1000 Internucleardistance,/pmR 0 BrCl NaBr KBr KBr NaBr BrCl Fig. 24.24 An example of the trajectories calculated for a complex-mode reaction, KCl + NaBr → KBr + NaCl, in which the collision cluster has a long lifetime. (P. Brumer and M. Karplus, Faraday Disc. Chem. Soc., 55, 80 (1973).) 892 24 MOLECULAR REACTION DYNAMICS where Pi,j(E) is the probability for a transition between a reacting channel i and a product channel j and the summation is over all possible transitions that lead to product. It is then possible to show that the rate constant is given by k(T) = (24.74) where Qr(T) is the partition function density (the partition function divided by the volume) of the reactants at the temperature T. The significance of eqn 24.74 is that it provides a direct connection between an experimental quantity, the rate constant, and a theoretical quantity, N(E). 24.9 The investigation of reaction dynamics with ultrafast laser techniques The development of femtosecond pulsed lasers (Section 14.6) has made it possible to make observations on species that have such short lifetimes that in a number of respects they resemble an activated complex. Pulsed-laser techniques can also be used to control the outcome of chemical reactions. (a) Spectroscopic observation of the activated complex Until very recently there were no direct spectroscopic observations on activated complexes, for they have a very fleeting existence and often survive for only a few picoseconds. In a typical experiment designed to detect an activated complex, a femtosecond laser pulse is used to excite a molecule to a dissociative state, and then a second femtosecond pulse is fired at an interval after the dissociating pulse. The frequency of the second pulse is set at an absorption of one of the free fragmentation products, so its absorption is a measure of the abundance of the dissociation product. For example, when ICN is dissociated by the first pulse, the emergence of CN from the photoactivated state can be monitored by watching the growth of the free CN absorption (or, more commonly, its laser-induced fluorescence). In this way it has been found that the CN signal remains zero until the fragments have separated by about 600 pm, which takes about 205 fs. Some sense of the progress that has been made in the study of the intimate mechanism of chemical reactions can be obtained by considering the decay of the ion pair Na+ I− . As shown in Fig. 24.25, excitation of the ionic species with a femtosecond laser pulse forms an excited state that corresponds to a covalently bonded NaI molecule. The system can be described with two potential energy surfaces, one largely ‘ionic’ and another ‘covalent’, which cross at an internuclear separation of 693 pm. A short laser pulse is composed of a wide range of frequencies, which excite many vibrational states of NaI simultaneously. Consequently, the electronically excited complex exists as a superposition of states, or a localized wavepacket (Section 8.6), which oscillates between the ‘covalent’ and ‘ionic’ potential energy surfaces, as shown in Fig. 24.25. The complex can also dissociate, shown as movement of the wavepacket toward very long internuclear separation along the dissociative surface. However, not every outward-going swing leads to dissociation because there is a chance that the I atom can be harpooned again, in which case it fails to make good its escape. The dynamics of the system is probed by a second laser pulse with a frequency that corresponds to the absorption frequency of the free Na product or to the frequency at which Na absorbs when it is a part of the complex. The latter frequency depends on the Na···I distance, so an absorption (in practice, a laser-induced fluorescence) is obtained each time the wavepacket returns to that separation. Ύ ∞ 0 N(E)e−E/kT dE hQr(T) Na I (covalent) + Na I (ionic) + + - Internuclear separation Potentialenergy Fig. 24.25 Excitation of the ion pair Na+ I− forms an excited state with covalent character. Also shown is movement between a ‘covalent’ surface (in green) and an ‘ionic’ surface (in purple) of the wavepacket formed by laser excitation. 24.9 THE INVESTIGATION OF REACTION DYNAMICS WITH ULTRAFAST LASER TECHNIQUES 893 A typical set of results is shown in Fig. 24.26. The bound Na absorption intensity shows up as a series of pulses that recur in about 1 ps, showing that the wavepacket oscillates with about that period. The decline in intensity shows the rate at which the complex can dissociate as the two atoms swing away from each other. The free Na absorption also grows in an oscillating manner, showing the periodicity of wavepacket oscillation, each swing of which gives it a chance to dissociate. The precise period of the oscillation in NaI is 1.25 ps, corresponding to a vibrational wavenumber of 27 cm−1 (recall that the activated complex theory assumes that such a vibration has a very low frequency). The complex survives for about ten oscillations. In contrast, although the oscillation frequency of NaBr is similar, it barely survives one oscillation. Femtosecond spectroscopy has also been used to examine analogues of the activated complex involved in bimolecular reactions. Thus, a molecular beam can be used to produce a van der Waals molecule (Section 18.6), such as IH···OCO. The HI bond can be dissociated by a femtosecond pulse, and the H atom is ejected towards the O atom of the neighbouring CO2 molecule to form HOCO. Hence, the van der Waals molecule is a source of a species that resembles the activated complex of the reaction H + CO2 → [HOCO]‡ → HO + CO The probe pulse is tuned to the OH radical, which enables the evolution of [HOCO]‡ to be studied in real time. Femtosecond transition state spectroscopy has also been used to study more complex reactions, such as the Diels–Alder reaction, nucleophilic substitutionreactions,andpericyclicadditionandcleavagereactions.Biologicalprocess that are open to study by femtosecond spectroscopy include the energy-converting processes of photosynthesis and the photostimulated processes of vision. In other experiments, the photoejection of carbon monoxide from myoglobin and the attachment of O2 to the exposed site have been studied to obtain rate constants for the two processes. (b) Controlling chemical reactions with lasers A long-standing goal of chemistry is to control the rate and distribution of products in chemical reactions, with an eye toward minimizing undesirable side reactions and improving the efficiency of industrial processes. We already have at our disposal a number of successful strategies for achieving this goal. For example, it is possible to synthesize a catalyst that accelerates a specific type of reaction but not others, so a desired product may be formed more quickly than an undesired product. However, this strategy is not very general, as a new catalyst needs to be developed for every reaction type of interest. A more ambitious and potentially more powerful strategy consists of using lasers to prepare specific states of reactant molecules that lead to a specific activated complex and hence a specific product, perhaps not even the major product isolated under ordinary laboratory conditions. Here we examine two ways in which the outcome of a chemical reaction can be affected by laser irradiation. Some reactions may be controlled by exciting the reactants to different vibrational states. Consider the gas-phase reaction between H and HOD. It has been observed that H2 and OD are the preferred products when thermally equilibrated H atoms react with vibrationally excited HOD molecules prepared by laser irradiation at a wavelength that excites the H-OD stretching mode from the v = 0 to the v = 4 energy level. On the other hand, when the same stretching mode is excited to the v = 5 energy level, HD and OH are the preferred products. This control strategy is commonly referred to as mode-selective chemistry and has been used to alter product distributions in a number of bimolecular reactions. However, the technique is limited to those cases in which energy can be deposited and remains localized in the desired vibrational mode of the reactant for a time that is much longer than the reaction time. This is difficult to -2 0 2 4 6 8 Time delay, /pst Intensity Free Na absorption NaI absorption Fig. 24.26 Femtosecond spectroscopic results for the reaction in which sodium iodide separates inot Na and I. The lower curve is the absorption of the electronically excited complex and the upper curve is the absorption of free Na atoms (Adapted from A.H. Zewail, Science 242, 1645 (1988)). 894 24 MOLECULAR REACTION DYNAMICS achieve in large molecules, in which intramolecular vibrational relaxation redistributes energy among the many vibrational modes within a few picoseconds. A strategy that seeks to avoid the problem of vibrational relaxation uses ultrafast lasers and is related closely to the techniques used for the spectroscopic detection of transition states. Consider the reaction I2 + Xe → XeI* + I, which occurs via a harpoon mechanism with a transition state denoted as [Xe+ ···I− ···I]. The reaction can be initiated by exciting I2 to an electronic state at least 52 460 cm−1 above the ground state and then followed by measuring the time dependence of the chemiluminescence of XeI*. To exert control over the yield of the product, a pair of femtosecond pulses can be used to induce the reaction. The first pulse excites the I2 molecule to a low energy and unreactive electronic state. We already know that excitation by a femtosecond pulse generates a wavepacket that can be treated as a particle travelling across the potential energy surface. In this case, the wavepacket does not have enough energy to react, but excitation by another laser pulse with the proper wavelength can provide the necessary additional energy. It follows that activated complexes with different geometries can be prepared by varying the time delay between the two pulses, as the partially localized wave packet will be at different locations along the potential energy surface as it evolves after being formed by the first pulse. Because the reaction occurs via the harpoon mechanism, the product yield is expected to be optimal if the second pulse is applied when the wave packet is at a point where the Xe···I2 distance is just right for electron transfer from Xe to I2 to occur (see Example 24.2). This type of control of the I2 + Xe reaction has been demonstrated. So far, the control techniques we have discussed have only been applied to reactions between relatively small molecules, with simple and well-understood potential energy surfaces. Extension of these techniques to the controlled synthesis of materials in routine laboratory work will require much more sophisticated knowledge of how laser pulses may be combined to stimulate a specific molecular response in a complex system. Electron transfer in homogeneous systems We end the chapter by applying the concepts of transition state theory and quantum theory to the study of a deceptively simple process, electron transfer between molecules in homogeneous systems. We begin by examining the features of a theory that describes the factors governing the rates of electron transfer. Then, we discuss the theory in the light of experimental results on a variety of systems, including protein complexes. We shall see that relatively simple expressions may be used to predict the rates of electron transfer with reasonable accuracy. 24.10 The rates of electron transfer processes Consider electron transfer from a donor species D to an acceptor species A in solution. The net reaction is D + A → D+ + A− v = kobs[D][A] K = (24.75) In the first step of the mechanism, D and A must diffuse through the solution and collide to form a complex DA, in which the donor and acceptor are separated by a distance comparable to r, the distance between the edges of each species. We assume that D, A, and DA are in equilibrium: [D+ ][A− ] [D][A] 24.10 THE RATES OF ELECTRON TRANSFER PROCESSES 895 D + A 5 DA KDA = = (24.76a) where ka and ka′ are, respectively, the rate constants for the association and dissociation of the DA complex. Next, electron transfer occurs within the DA complex to yield D+ A− : DA → D+ A− vet = ket[DA] (24.76b) where ket is the first-order rate constant for the forward electron transfer step. The D+ A− complex has two possible fates. First, reverse electron transfer with a rate constant kr can regenerate DA: D+ A− → DA vr = kr[D+ A− ] (24.76c) Second, D+ A− can break apart and the ions diffuse through the solution: D+ A− → D+ + A− vd = kd[D+ A− ] (24.76d) We show in the following Justification that = + 1 + (24.77) Justification 24.4 The rate constant for electron transfer in solution To find an expression for the second-order rate constant kobs for electron transfer between D and A in solution, we begin by equating the rate of the net reaction (eqn 24.75) to the rate of formation of separated ions, the reaction products (eqn 24.76d): v = kobs[D][A] = kd[D+ A− ] Now we apply the steady-state approximation to the intermediate D+ A− : = ket[DA] − kr[D+ A− ] − kd[D+ A− ] = 0 It follows that [D+ A− ] = [DA] However, DA is also an intermediate so we apply the steady-state approximation again = ka[D][A] − k′a[DA] − ket[DA] + kr[D+ A− ] = 0 Substitution of the initial expression for the steady-state concentration of D+ A− into this expression for [DA] gives, after some algebra, a new expression for [D+ A− ]: [D+ A− ] = [D][A] When we multiply this expression by kd, we see that the resulting equation has the form of the rate of electron transfer, v = kobs[D][A], with kobs given by kobs = To obtain eqn 24.77, we divide the numerator and denominator on the right-hand side of this expression by kdket and solve for the reciprocal of kobs. kdkaket k′akr + k′akd + kdket kaket k′akr + k′akd + kdket d[DA] dt ket kr + kd d[D+ A− ] dt D F kr kd A C k′a kaket 1 ka 1 kobs [DA] [D][A] ka k′a 896 24 MOLECULAR REACTION DYNAMICS To gain insight into eqn 24.77 and the factors that determine the rate of electron transfer reactions in solution, we assume that the main decay route for D+ A− is dissociation of the complex into separated ions, or kd >> kr. It follows that ≈ 1 + When ket >> k′a, we see that kobs ≈ ka and the rate of product formation is controlled by diffusion of D and A in solution, which fosters formation of the DA complex. When ket << k′a, we see that kobs ≈ (ka/k′a)ket or, after using eqn 24.76a, kobs ≈ KDAket (24.78) and the process is controlled by the activation energy of electron transfer in the DA complex. Using transition state theory (Section 24.4), we write ket = κνe−∆‡ G/RT (24.79) where κ is the transmission coefficient, ν is the vibrational frequency with which the activated complex approaches the transition state, and ∆‡ G is the Gibbs energy of activation. Our first task is to write theoretical expressions for κν and ∆‡ G by describing the motions of electrons and nuclei mathematically. 24.11 Theory of electron transfer processes Our discussion concentrates on the following two key aspects of the theory, which was developed independently by R.A. Marcus, N.S. Hush, V.G. Levich, and R.R. Dogonadze: 1 Electrons are transferred by tunnelling through a potential energy barrier, the height of which is partly determined by the ionization energies of the DA and D+ A− complexes. Electron tunnelling influences the magnitude of κν. 2 The complex DA and the solvent molecules surrounding it undergo structural rearrangements prior to electron transfer. The energy associated with these rearrangements and the standard reaction Gibbs energy determine ∆‡ G. (a) Electron tunnelling We saw in Section 14.2 that, according to the Franck–Condon principle, electronic transitions are so fast that they can be regarded as taking place in a stationary nuclear framework. This principle also applies to an electron transfer process in which an electron migrates from one energy surface, representing the dependence of the energy of DA on its geometry, to another representing the energy of D+ A− . We can represent the potential energy (and the Gibbs energy) surfaces of the two complexes (the reactant complex, DA, and the product complex, D+ A− ) by the parabolas characteristic of harmonic oscillators, with the displacement coordinate corresponding to the changing geometries (Fig. 24.27). This coordinate represents a collective mode of the donor, acceptor, and solvent. According to the Franck–Condon principle, the nuclei do not have time to move when the system passes from the reactant to the product surface as a result of the transfer of an electron. Therefore, electron transfer can occur only after thermal fluctuations bring the geometry of DA to q* in Fig. 24.27, the value of the nuclear coordinate at which the two parabolas intersect. The factor κν is a measure of the probability that the system will convert from reactants (DA) to products (D+ A− ) at q* by electron transfer within the thermally excited DA complex. To understand the process, we must turn our attention to the D F k′a ket A C 1 ka 1 kobs Gibbsenergy DA D A + - DrG° l q0 R q* q0 P Displacement, q D ‡ G Fig. 24.27 The Gibbs energy surfaces of the complexes DA and D+ A− involved in an electron transfer process are represented by parabolas characteristic of harmonic oscillators, with the displacement coordinate q corresponding to the changing geometries of the system. In the plot, q0 R and q0 P are the values of q at which the minima of the reactant and product parabolas occur, respectively. The parabolas intersect at q = q*. The plots also portray the Gibbs energy of activation, ∆‡ G, the standard reaction Gibbs energy, ∆rG7 , and the reorganization energy, λ (discussed in Section 24.11b). 24.11 THEORY OF ELECTRON TRANSFER PROCESSES 897 effect that the rearrangement of nuclear coordinates has on electronic energy levels of DA and D+ A− for a given distance r between D and A (Fig. 24.28). Initially, the electron to be transferred occupies the HOMO of D, and the overall energy of DA is lower than that of D+ A− (Fig. 24.28a). As the nuclei rearrange to a configuration represented by q* in Fig. 24.28b, the highest occupied electronic level of DA and the lowest unoccupied electronic level of D+ A− become degenerate and electron transfer becomes energetically feasible. Over reasonably short distances r, the main mechanism of electron transfer is tunnelling through the potential energy barrier depicted in Fig. 24.28b. The height of the barrier increases with the ionization energies of the DA and D+ A− complexes. After an electron moves from the HOMO of D to the LUMO of A, the system relaxes to the configuration represented by q0 P in Fig. 24.28c. As shown in the illustration, now the energy of D+ A− is lower than that of DA, reflecting the thermodynamic tendency for A to remain reduced and for D to remain oxidized. The tunnelling event responsible for electron transfer is similar to that described in Section 9.3, except that in this case the electron tunnels from an electronic level of D, with wavefunction ψD, to an electronic level of A, with wavefunction ψA. We saw in Section 9.3 that the rate of an electronic transition from a level described by the wavefunction ψD to a level described by ψA is proportional to the square of the integral ͗HDA͘= ΎψA@DAψBdτ where HDA is a hamiltonian that describes the coupling of the electronic wavefunctions. It turns out that in cases where the coupling is relatively weak we may write: ͗HDA͘2 = ͗H°DA͘2 e−βr (24.80) where r is the edge-to-edge distance between D and A, β is a parameter that measures the sensitivity of the electronic coupling matrix element to distance, and ͗H°DA͘2 is the value of the electronic coupling matrix element when D and A are in contact (r = 0). The exponential dependence on distance in eqn 24.80 is essentially the same as the exponential decrease in transmission probability through a potential energy barrier described in Section 9.3. (b) The expression for the rate of electron transfer The full expression for ket turns out to be (see Further reading for a derivation) ket = 1/2 e−∆‡ G/RT (24.81) where ͗HDA͘2 can be approximated by eqn 24.80. We show in Further information 24.1 that the Gibbs energy of activation ∆‡ G is ∆‡ G = (24.82) where ∆rG7 is the standard reaction Gibbs energy for the electron transfer process DA → D+ A− , and λ is the reorganization energy, the energy change associated with molecular rearrangements that must take place so that DA can take on the equilibrium geometry of D+ A− . These molecular rearrangements include the relative reorientation of the D and A molecules in DA and the relative reorientation of the solvent molecules surrounding DA. Equation 24.82 shows that ∆‡ G = 0, with the implication that the reaction is not slowed down by an activation barrier, when ∆rG7 = −λ, corresponding to the cancellation of the reorganization energy term by the standard reaction Gibbs energy. (∆rG7 + λ)2 4λ D F π3 4λRT A C 2͗HDA͘2 h DA D A + - q0 R *q Nuclear displacement q0 P Energy DA Energy Electron transfer DA Energy Electronic displacement (a) (b) (c) r DA DA DA V D A+ D A+ D A+ D A+ D A+ Fig. 24.28 Correspondence between the electronic energy levels (shown on the left) and the nuclear energy levels (shown on the right) for the DA and D+ A− complexes involved in an electron transfer process. (a) At the nuclear configuration denoted by q0 R , the electron to be transferred in DA is in an occupied electronic energy level (denoted by a blue circle) and the lowest unoccupied energy level of D+ A− (denoted by an unfilled circle) is of too high an energy to be a good electron acceptor. (b) As the nuclei rearrange to a configuration represented by q*, DA and D+ A− become degenerate and electron transfer occurs by tunnelling through the barrier of height V and width r, the edge-to-edge distance between donor and acceptor. (c) The system relaxes to the equilibrium nuclear configuration of D+ A− denoted by q0 P , in which the lowest unoccupied electronic level of DA is higher in energy than the highest occupied electronic level of D+ A− . (Adapted from R.A. Marcus and N. Sutin, Biochim. Biophys. Acta 811, 265 (1985).) 898 24 MOLECULAR REACTION DYNAMICS Equation 24.81 has some limitations. First, it describes only those processes with weak electronic coupling between donor and acceptor. Weak coupling is observed when the electroactive species are sufficiently far apart that the wavefunctions ψA and ψD do not overlap extensively. An example of a weakly coupled system is the cytochrome c–cytochrome b5 complex, in which the electroactive haem-bound iron ions shuttle between oxidation states +2 and +3 during electron transfer and are about 1.7 nm apart. Strong coupling is observed when the wavefunctions ψA and ψD overlap very extensively. Examples of strongly coupled systems are mixed-valence, binuclear d-metal complexes with the general structure LmMn+ -B-Mp+ Lm, in which the electroactive metal ions are separated by a bridging ligand B. In these systems, r < 1.0 nm. The weak coupling limit applies to a large number of electron transfer reactions, including those between proteins during metabolism (Impact I7.2). Second, the term (π3 /4λRT)1/2 e−∆‡ G/RT should be used only at high temperatures. At low temperatures, thermal fluctuations alone cannot bring the reactants to the transition state and transition state theory, which is at the heart of the theory presented in this section, fails to account for any observed electron transfer. Electron transfer can still occur, but by nuclear tunnelling from the reactant to the product surfaces. We saw in Section 9.5 that the wavefunctions for the lower levels of the quantum mechanical harmonic oscillator extend significantly beyond classically allowed regions, so an oscillator can tunnel into a region of space in which another oscillator may be found. Full quantum mechanical treatments of electron transfer reactions replace the (π3 /4λRT)1/2 e−∆‡ G/RT term with Franck–Condon factors similar to those discussed in Section 14.2, which couple the nuclear wavefunctions and provide a measure of the contribution of nuclear tunnelling to the rate of electron transfer. 24.12 Experimental results It is difficult to measure the distance dependence of ket when the reactants are ions or molecules that are free to move in solution. In such cases, electron transfer occurs after a donor–acceptor complex forms and it is not possible to exert control over r, the edge-to-edge distance. The most meaningful experimental tests of the dependence of ket on r are those in which the same donor and acceptor are positioned at a variety of distances, perhaps by covalent attachment to molecular linkers (see 1 for an example). Under these conditions, the term e−∆‡ G/RT becomes a constant and, after taking the natural logarithm of eqn 24.81 and using eqn 24.80, we obtain ln ket = −βr + constant (24.83) which implies that a plot of ln ket against r should be a straight line with slope −β. The value of β depends on the medium through which the electron must travel from donor to acceptor. In a vacuum, 28 nm−1 < β < 35 nm−1 , whereas β ≈ 9 nm−1 when the intervening medium is a molecular link between donor and acceptor. The dependence of ket on the standard reaction Gibbs energy has been investigated in systems where the edge-to-edge distance, the reorganization energy, and κν are constant for a series of reactions. Then eqn 24.81 becomes ln ket = − 2 − 1 –2 + constant (24.84) and a plot of ln ket (or log ket) against ∆rG7 (or −∆rG7 ) is predicted to be shaped like a downward parabola. Equation 24.84 implies that the rate constant increases as ∆rG7 decreases but only up to −∆rG7 = λ. Beyond that, the reaction enters the inverted region, in which the rate constant decreases as the reaction becomes more exergonic (∆rG7 becomes more negative). The inverted region has been observed in a series of D F ∆rG7 RT A C D F ∆rG7 RT A C 1 4λ 24.12 EXPERIMENTAL RESULTS 899 special compounds in which the electron donor and acceptor are linked covalently to a molecular spacer of known and fixed size (Fig. 24.29). The behaviour predicted by eqn 24.84 and observed experimentally in Fig. 24.29 can be explained by considering the dependence of the activation Gibbs energy on the standard Gibbs energy of electron transfer. We suppose that the energies of the reactant and product complexes can be characterized by parabolas with identical curvatures and fixed but distinct q0 R and q0 P . Now we let the minimum energy of the product complex change while keeping q0 P constant, which corresponds to changing the magnitude of ∆rG7 . Figure 24.30 shows the effect of increasing the exergonicity of the process. In Fig. 24.30a we see that, for a range of values of ∆rG7 , ∆‡ G > 0 and the transition state is at qa* > q0 R . As the process becomes more exergonic, the activation Gibbs energy decreases and the rate constant increases. (This behaviour is another example of a ‘linear free-energy relation’, first discussed in Section 24.5.) Figure 24.30b shows that, when ∆‡ G = 0 and qb* = q0 R , the rate constant for the process reaches a maximum as there is no activation barrier to overcome. According to eqn 24.81, this condition occurs when −∆rG7 = λ. Finally, Fig. 24.30c shows that, as the process becomes even more exergonic, ∆‡ G becomes positive again but now the transition state is at qc* < q0 R . The rate constant for the process decreases steadily as the activation barrier for the process increases with decreasing ∆rG7 . This is the explanation for the ‘inverted region’ observed in Fig. 24.29. (a) (b) (c) (d) (e) (f) (g) (h) 0 0.5 1 1.5 2 1010 108 109 10 7 106 ket/s-1 -DrG°/eV 2.5 Fig. 24.29 Variation of log ket with −∆rG7 for a series of compounds with the structures given in (1). Kinetic measurements were conducted in 2-methyltetrahydrofuran and at 296 K. The distance between donor (the reduced biphenyl group) and the acceptor is constant for all compounds in the series because the molecular linker remains the same. Each acceptor has a characteristic standard reduction potential, so it follows that the standard Gibbs energy for the electron transfer process is different for each compound in the series. The line is a fit to a version of eqn 24.84 and the maximum of the parabola occurs at −∆rG7 = λ = 1.2 eV = 1.2 × 102 kJ mol−1 . (Reproduced with permission from J.R. Miller, L.T. Calcaterra, and G.L. Closs, J. Amer. Chem. Soc. 106, 3047 (1984).) 900 24 MOLECULAR REACTION DYNAMICS Some of the key features of electron transfer theory have been tested by experiments, showing in particular the predicted dependence of ket on the standard reaction Gibbs energy and the edge-to-edge distance between electron donor and acceptor. The basic theory presented in Section 24.11 has been extended to transfer of other light particles, such as protons. IMPACT ON BIOCHEMISTRY I24.1 Electron transfer in and between proteins We saw in Impact I7.2 and I21.2 that exergonic electron transfer processes drive the synthesis of ATP in the mitochondrion during oxidative phosphorylation. Electron transfer between protein-bound cofactors or between proteins also plays a role in other biological processes, such as photosynthesis (Impact I23.2), nitrogen fixation, the reduction of atmospheric N2 to NH3 by certain microorganisms, and the mechanisms of action of oxidoreductases, which are enzymes that catalyse redox reactions. Equation 24.78 applies to a large number of biological systems, such as cytochrome c and cytochrome c oxidase (Impact I7.2), which must form an encounter complex before electron transfer can take place. Electron transfer between protein-bound cofactors can occur at distances of up to about 2.0 nm, a relatively long distance on a molecular scale, with the protein providing an intervening medium between donor and acceptor. When the electron donor and acceptor are anchored at fixed distances within a single protein, only ket needs to be considered when calculating the rate of electron transfer by using eqn 24.81. Cytochrome c oxidase is an example of a system where such intraprotein electron transfer is important. In that enzyme, bound copper ions and haem groups work together to reduce O2 to water in the final step of respiration. However, there is a great deal of controversy surrounding the interpretation of protein electron transfer data in the light of the theory that leads to eqn 24.81. Much of the available data may be interpreted with β ≈ 14 nm−1 , a value that appears to be insensitive to the primary and secondary structures of the protein but does depend slightly on the density of atoms in the section of protein that separates donor from acceptor. More detailed work on the specific effect of secondary structure suggests that 12.5 nm−1 < β < 16.0 nm−1 when the intervening medium consists primarily of α helices and 9.0 nm−1 < β < 11.5 nm−1 when the medium is primarily β sheet. Yet another view suggests that the electron takes specific paths through covalent bonds and hydrogen bonds that exist in the protein for the purpose of optimizing the rate of electron transfer. A value of β is not necessary for the prediction of the rate constants for electron transfer processes between proteins if we take a different approach. It follows from eqns 24.78 and 24.79 that the rate constant kobs may be written as kobs = Ze−∆‡ G/RT (24.85) where Z = KDAκν. It is difficult to estimate kobs because we often lack knowledge of β, λ, and κν. However, when λ >> |∆rG7 |, kobs may be estimated by a special case of the Marcus cross-relation, which we derive in Further information 24.1: kobs = (kDDkAAK)1/2 (24.86) where K is the equilibrium constant for the net electron transfer reaction (eqn 24.75) and kDD and kAA are the experimental rate constants for the electron self-exchange processes (with the asterisks distinguishing one molecule from another) *D + D+ → *D+ + D (24.87a) *A− + A → *A + A− (24.87b) Energy (c) DA D A+ - (b) (a) q*(a) Nuclear displacement q*(b)q*(c) q0 P q0 R Fig. 24.30 (a) ∆‡ G > 0 and the transition state is at qa* > q0 R . As the process becomes more exergonic, the activation Gibbs energy decreases and the rate constant increases. (b) When ∆‡ G = 0 and qb* = q0 R the rate constant for the process reaches a maximum as there is no activation barrier to overcome. (c) As the process becomes even more exergonic, ∆‡ G becomes positive again but now the transition state is at qc* < q0 R . The rate constant for the process decreases steadily as the activation barrier for the process increases with decreasing ∆rG7 . I24.1 IMPACT ON BIOCHEMISTRY: ELECTRON TRANSFER IN AND BETWEEN PROTEINS 901 The rate constants estimated by eqn 24.86 agree fairly well with experimental rate constants for electron transfer between proteins, as we see in the following Example. Example 24.4 Using the Marcus cross-relation The following kinetic and thermodynamic data were obtained for cytochrome c and cytochrome c551, two proteins in which haem-bound iron ions shuttle between the oxidation states Fe(II) and Fe(III): kii/(dm3 mol−1 s−1 ) E 7 /V cytochrome c 1.5 × 102 0.260 cytochrome c551 4.6 × 107 0.286 Estimate the rate constant kobs for the process cytochrome c551(red) + cytochrome c(ox) → cytochrome c551(ox) + cytochrome c(red) Then, compare the estimated value with the observed value of 6.7 × 104 dm3 mol−1 s−1 . Method We use the standard potentials and eqns 7.30 (ln K = νFE7 /RT) and 7.37 (E7 = ER 7 − EL 7 ) to calculate the equilibrium constant K. Then, we use eqn 24.86, the calculated value of K, and the self-exchange rate constants kii to calculate the rate constant kobs. Answer The two reduction half-reactions are Right: cytochrome c(ox) + e− → cytochrome c(red) ER 7 = +0.260 V Left: cytochrome c551(ox) + e− → cytochrome c551(red) EL 7 = +0.286 V The difference is E7 = (0.260 V) − (0.286 V) = −0.026 V It then follows from eqn 7.30 with ν = 1 and RT/F = 25.69 mV that ln K = − = − Therefore, K = 0.36. From eqn 24.76 and the self-exchange rate constants, we calculate kobs = {(1.5 × 102 dm3 mol−1 s−1 ) × (4.6 × 107 dm3 mol−1 s−1 ) × 0.36}1/2 = 5.0 × 104 dm3 mol−1 s−1 The calculated and observed values differ by only 25 per cent, indicating that the Marcus relation can lead to reasonable estimates of rate constants for electron transfer. Self-test 24.4 Estimate kobs for the reduction by cytochrome c of plastocyanin, a protein containing a copper ion that shuttles between the +2 and +1 oxidation states and for which kAA = 6.6 × 102 dm3 mol−1 s−1 and E7 = 0.350 V. [1.8 × 103 dm3 mol−1 s−1 ] 2.6 2.569 0.026V 25.69 × 10−3 V 902 24 MOLECULAR REACTION DYNAMICS Checklist of key ideas 1. In collision theory, it is supposed that the rate is proportional to the collision frequency, a steric factor, and the fraction of collisions that occur with at least the kinetic energy Ea along their lines of centres. 2. A reaction in solution may be diffusion-controlled if its rate is controlled by the rate at which reactant molecules encounter each other in solution. The rate of an activation-controlled reaction is controlled by the rate of accumulating sufficient energy. 3. In transition state theory, it is supposed that an activated complex is in equilibrium with the reactants, and that the rate at which that complex forms products depends on the rate at which it passes through a transition state. The result is the Eyring equation, k2 = κ(kT/h)I‡ c. 4. The rate constant may be parametrized in terms of the Gibbs energy, entropy, and enthalpy of activation, k2 = (kT/h)e∆*S/R e−∆*H/RT . 5. The kinetic salt effect is the effect of an added inert salt on the rate of a reaction between ions, log k2 = log k°2 + 2AzAzBI1/2 . 6. Techniques for the study of reactive collisions include infrared chemiluminescence, laser-induced fluorescence, multiphoton ionization (MPI), reaction product imaging, and resonant multiphoton ionization (REMPI). 7. A potential energy surface maps the potential energy as a function of the relative positions of all the atoms taking part in a reaction. In an attractive surface, the saddle point (the highest point) occurs early on the reaction coordinate. In a repulsive surface, the saddle point occurs late on the reaction coordinate. 8. Ultrafast laser techniques can be used to probe directly the activated complex and to control the outcome of some chemical reactions. 9. The rate constant of electron transfer in a donor–acceptor complex depends on the distance between electron donor and acceptor, the standard reaction Gibbs energy, and the reorganization energy, λ: ket ∝ e−βr e−∆‡ G/RT (constant T), with ∆‡ G = (∆rG7 + λ)2 /4λ. 10. The Marcus cross-relation predicts the rate constant for electron transfer in solution from the reaction’s equilibrium constant K and the self-exchange rate constants kii: kobs = (kDDkAAK)1/2 . Table 24.3 Summary of uses of k Symbol Significance k Boltzmann’s constant k2 Second-order rate constant k2° Rate constant at zero ionic strength ka, kb, . . . Rate constants for individual steps k′a, k′b, . . . Rate constants for individual reverse steps k‡ Rate constant for unimolecular decay of activated complex K Equilibrium constant (dimensionless) Kγ Ratio of activity coefficients K‡ Proportionality constant in transition state theory κ Transmission coefficient I Equilibrium constant with one mode discarded kf Force constant FURTHER INFORMATION 903 Further reading Articles and texts A.J. Alexander and R.N. Zare, Anatomy of elementary chemical reactions. J. Chem. Educ. 75, 1105 (1998). G.D. Billing and K.V. Mikkelsen, Advanced molecular dynamics and chemical kinetics. Wiley, New York (1997). D.C. Clary, Quantum theory of chemical reaction dynamics. Science 279, 1879 (1998). F.F. Crim, Vibrational state control of bimolecular reactions: discovering and directing the chemistry. Acc. Chem. Res. 32, 877 (1999). D.M. Hirst, Potential energy surfaces. Taylor and Francis, London (1985). A.M. Kuznetsov and J. Ulstrup, Electron transfer in chemistry and biology: an introduction to the theory. Wiley, New York (1998). R.D. Levine and R.B. Bernstein, Molecular reaction dynamics and chemical reactivity. Clarendon Press, Oxford (1987). J.I. Steinfeld, J.S. Francisco and W.L. Hase, Chemical kinetics and dynamics. Prentice Hall, Upper Saddle River (1999). A.H. Zewail, Femtochemistry: atomic-scale dynamics of the chemical bond using ultrafast lasers. Angew. Chem. Int. Ed. 39, 2586 (2000). Further information Further information 24.1 The Gibbs energy of activation of electron transfer and the Marcus cross-relation The simplest way to derive an expression for the Gibbs energy of activation of electron transfer processes is to construct a model in which the surfaces for DA (the ‘reactant complex’, denoted R) and for D+ A− (the ‘product complex’, denoted P) are described by classical harmonic oscillators with identical reduced masses µ and angular frequencies ω, but displaced minima, as shown in Fig. 24.27. The molar Gibbs energies Gm,R(q) and Gm,P(q) of the reactant and product complexes, respectively, may be written as Gm,R(q) = 1–2NAµω2 (q − q0 R )2 + Gm,R(q0 R ) (24.88a) Gm,P(q) = 1–2NAµω2 (q − q0 P )2 + Gm,P(q0 P ) (24.88b) where q0 R and q0 P are the values of q at which the minima of the reactant and product parabolas occur, respectively. The standard reaction Gibbs energy for the electron transfer process DA → D+ A− is ∆rG7 = Gm,P(q0 P ) − Gm,R(q0 R ), the difference in standard molar Gibbs energy between the minima of the parabolas. In Fig. 24.27, ∆rG7 < 0. We also note that q*, the value of q corresponding to the transition state of the complex, may be written in terms of the parameter α, the fractional change in q: q* = q0 R + α(q0 P − q0 R ) (24.89) We see from Fig. 24.27 that ∆‡ G = Gm,R(q*) − Gm,R(q0 R ). It then follows from eqns 24.88a, 24.88b, and 24.89 that ∆‡ G = 1–2NAµω2 (q* − q0 R )2 = 1–2NAµω2 {α(q0 P − q0 R )}2 (24.90) We now define the reorganization energy, λ, as λ = 1–2NAµω2 (q0 P − q0 R )2 (24.91) which can be interpreted as Gm,R(q0 P ) − Gm,R(q0 R ) and, consequently, as the (Gibbs) energy required to deform the equilibrium configuration of DA to the equilibrium configuration of D+ A− (as shown in Fig. 24.27). It follows from eqns 24.90 and 24.91 that ∆‡ G = α2 λ (24.92) Because Gm,R(q*) = Gm,P(q*), it follows from eqns 24.88b, 24.91, and 24.92 that α2 λ = 1–2NAµω2 {(α − 1)(q0 P − q0 R )}2 + ∆rG7 = (α − 1)λ + ∆rG7 (24.93) which implies that α = 1–2 + 1 (24.94) By combining eqns 24.92 and 24.94, we obtain eqn 24.82. We can obtain an identical relation if we allow the harmonic oscillators to have different angular frequencies and hence different curvatures (see Further reading). Equation 24.82 can be used to derive the form of the Marcus cross-relation (eqn 24.86) used in Impact I24.1. We begin by using eqn 24.85 to write the rate constants for the self-exchange reactions as kDD = ZDDe−∆‡ GDD/RT kAA = ZAAe−∆‡ GAA/RT For the net reaction (also called the ‘cross-reaction’) and the selfexchange reactions, the Gibbs energy of activation may be written from eqn 24.82 as ∆‡ G = + + When λ >> |∆rG7 |, we obtain ∆‡ G = + This expression can be used without further elaboration to denote the Gibbs energy of activation of the net reaction. For the self-exchange reactions, we set ∆rG7 DD = ∆rG7 AA = 0 and write ∆‡ GDD = ∆‡ GAA = λAA 4 λDD 4 λ 4 ∆rG7 2 λ 4 ∆rG7 2 ∆rG72 4λ D E F ∆rG7 λ A B C 904 24 MOLECULAR REACTION DYNAMICS It follows that kDD = ZDDe−λDD/4RT kAA = ZAAe−λAA/4RT To make further progress, we assume that the reorganization energy of the net reaction is the arithmetic mean of the reorganization energies of the self-exchange reactions: λDA = It follows that the Gibbs energy of activation of the net reaction is ∆‡ G = + + Therefore, the rate constant for the net reaction is kobs = Ze−∆rG7/2RT e−λDD/8RT e−λAA/8RT λAA 8 λDD 8 ∆rG7 2 λDD + λAA 2 We can use eqn 7.17 (ln K = −∆rG7 /RT) to write K = e−∆rG7/RT Then, by combining this expression with the expressions for kDD and kAA, and using the relations ex+y = ex ey and ex/2 = (ex )1/2 , we obtain the most general case of the Marcus cross-relation: kobs = (kDDkAAK)1/2 f where f = In practice, the factor f is usually set to 1 and we obtain eqn 24.86. Z (ZAAZDD)1/2 Discussion questions 24.1 Describe the essential features of the harpoon mechanism. 24.2 Distinguish between a diffusion-controlled reaction and an activationcontrolled reaction. 24.3 Describe the formulation of the Eyring equation. 24.4 Discuss the physical origin of the kinetic salt effect. 24.5 Describe how the following techniques are used in the study of chemical dynamics: infrared chemiluminescence, laser-induced fluorescence, multiphoton ionization, resonant multiphoton ionization, reaction product imaging, and femtosecond spectroscopy. 24.6 Justify the following statements: (a) Reactions with attractive potential energy surfaces proceed more efficiently if the energy is in relative translational motion. (b) Reactions with repulsive potential surfaces proceed more efficiently if the excess energy is present as vibrations. 24.7 A method for directing the outcome of a chemical reaction consists of using molecular beams to control the relative orientations of reactants during a collision. Consider the reaction Rb + CH3I → RbI + CH3. How should CH3I molecules and Rb atoms be oriented to maximize the production of RbI? 24.8 Discuss how the following factors determine the rate of electron transfer in homogeneous systems: the distance between electron donor and acceptor, and the reorganization energy of redox active species and the surrounding medium. Exercises 24.1a Calculate the collision frequency, z, and the collision density, Z, in ammonia, R = 190 pm, at 25°C and 100 kPa. What is the percentage increase when the temperature is raised by 10 K at constant volume? 24.1b Calculate the collision frequency, z, and the collision density, Z, in carbon monoxide, R = 180 pm at 25°C and 100 kPa. What is the percentage increase when the temperature is raised by 10 K at constant volume? 24.2a Collision theory demands knowing the fraction of molecular collisions having at least the kinetic energy Ea along the line of flight. What is this fraction when (a) Ea = 10 kJ mol−1 , (b) Ea = 100 kJ mol−1 at (i) 300 K and (ii) 1000 K? 24.2b Collision theory demands knowing the fraction of molecular collisions having at least the kinetic energy Ea along the line of flight. What is this fraction when (a) Ea = 15 kJ mol−1 , (b) Ea = 150 kJ mol−1 at (i) 300 K and (ii) 800 K? 24.3a Calculate the percentage increase in the fractions in Exercise 24.2a when the temperature is raised by 10 K. 24.3b Calculate the percentage increase in the fractions in Exercise 24.2b when the temperature is raised by 10 K. 24.4a Use the collision theory of gas-phase reactions to calculate the theoretical value of the second-order rate constant for the reaction H2(g) + I2(g) → 2 HI(g) at 650 K, assuming that it is elementary bimolecular. The collision cross-section is 0.36 nm2 , the reduced mass is 3.32 × 10−27 kg, and the activation energy is 171 kJ mol−1 . 24.4b Use the collision theory of gas-phase reactions to calculate the theoretical value of the second-order rate constant for the reaction D2(g) + Br2(g) → 2 DBr(g) at 450 K, assuming that it is elementary bimolecular. Take the collision cross-section as 0.30 nm2 , the reduced mass as 3.930 u, and the activation energy as 200 kJ mol−1 . 24.5a A typical diffusion coefficient for small molecules in aqueous solution at 25°C is 5 × 10−9 m2 s−1 . If the critical reaction distance is 0.4 nm, what value is expected for the second-order rate constant for a diffusion-controlled reaction? 24.5b Suppose that the typical diffusion coefficient for a reactant in aqueous solution at 25°C is 4.2 × 10−9 m2 s−1 . If the critical reaction distance is 0.50 nm, what value is expected for the second-order rate constant for the diffusioncontrolled reaction? PROBLEMS 905 24.6a Calculate the magnitude of the diffusion-controlled rate constant at 298 K for a species in (a) water, (b) pentane. The viscosities are 1.00 × 10−3 kg m−1 s−1 , and 2.2 × 10−4 kg m−1 s−1 , respectively. 24.6b Calculate the magnitude of the diffusion-controlled rate constant at 298 K for a species in (a) decylbenzene, (b) concentrated sulfuric acid. The viscosities are 3.36 cP and 27 cP, respectively. 24.7a Calculate the magnitude of the diffusion-controlled rate constant at 298 K for the recombination of two atoms in water, for which η = 0.89 cP. Assuming the concentration of the reacting species is 1.0 mmol dm−3 initially, how long does it take for the concentration of the atoms to fall to half that value? Assume the reaction is elementary. 24.7b Calculate the magnitude of the diffusion-controlled rate constant at 298 K for the recombination of two atoms in benzene, for which η = 0.601 cP. Assuming the concentration of the reacting species is 1.8 mmol dm−3 initially, how long does it take for the concentration of the atoms to fall to half that value? Assume the reaction is elementary. 24.8a For the gaseous reaction A + B → P, the reactive cross-section obtained from the experimental value of the pre-exponential factor is 9.2 × 10−22 m2 . The collision cross-sections of A and B estimated from the transport properties are 0.95 and 0.65 nm2 , respectively. Calculate the P-factor for the reaction. 24.8b For the gaseous reaction A + B → P, the reactive cross-section obtained from the experimental value of the pre-exponential factor is 8.7 × 10−22 m2 . The collision cross-sections of A and B estimated from the transport properties are 0.88 and 0.40 nm2 , respectively. Calculate the P factor for the reaction. 24.9a Two neutral species, A and B, with diameters 588 pm and 1650 pm, respectively, undergo the diffusion-controlled reaction A + B → P in a solvent of viscosity 2.37 × 10−3 kg m−1 s−1 at 40°C. Calculate the initial rate d[P]/dt if the initial concentrations of A and B are 0.150 mol dm−3 and 0.330 mol dm−3 , respectively. 24.9b Two neutral species, A and B, with diameters 442 pm and 885 pm, respectively, undergo the diffusion-controlled reaction A + B → P in a solvent of viscosity 1.27 cP at 20°C. Calculate the initial rate d[P]/dt if the initial concentrations of A and B are 0.200 mol dm−3 and 0.150 mol dm−3 , respectively. 24.10a The reaction of propylxanthate ion in acetic acid buffer solutions has the mechanism A− + H+ → P. Near 30°C the rate constant is given by the empirical expression k2 = (2.05 × 1013 )e−(8681 K)/T dm3 mol−1 s−1 . Evaluate the energy and entropy of activation at 30°C. 24.10b The reaction A− + H+ → P has a rate constant given by the empirical expression k2 = (8.72 × 1012 )e−(6134 K)/T dm3 mol−1 s−1 . Evaluate the energy and entropy of activation at 25°C. 24.11a When the reaction in Exercise 24.10a occurs in a dioxane/water mixture that is 30 per cent dioxane by mass, the rate constant fits k2 = (7.78 × 1014 )e−(9134 K)/T dm3 mol−1 s−1 near 30°C. Calculate ∆‡ G for the reaction at 30°C. 24.11b A rate constant is found to fit the expression k2 = (6.45 × 1013 ) e−(5375 K)/T dm3 mol−1 s−1 near 25°C. Calculate ∆‡ G for the reaction at 25°C. 24.12a The gas-phase association reaction between F2 and IF5 is first-order in each of the reactants. The energy of activation for the reaction is 58.6 kJ mol−1 . At 65°C the rate constant is 7.84 × 10−3 kPa−1 s−1 . Calculate the entropy of activation at 65°C. 24.12b A gas-phase recombination reaction is first-order in each of the reactants. The energy of activation for the reaction is 49.6 kJ mol−1 . At 55°C the rate constant is 0.23 m3 s−1 . Calculate the entropy of activation at 55°C. 24.13a Calculate the entropy of activation for a collision between two structureless particles at 300 K, taking M = 50 g mol−1 and σ = 0.40 nm2 . 24.13b Calculate the entropy of activation for a collision between two structureless particles at 500 K, taking M = 78 g mol−1 and σ = 0.62 nm2 . 24.14a The pre-exponential factor for the gas-phase decomposition of ozone at low pressures is 4.6 × 1012 dm3 mol−1 s−1 and its activation energy is 10.0 kJ mol−1 . What are (a) the entropy of activation, (b) the enthalpy of activation, (c) the Gibbs energy of activation at 298 K? 24.14b The pre-exponential factor for a gas-phase decomposition of ozone at low pressures is 2.3 × 1013 dm3 mol−1 s−1 and its activation energy is 30.0 kJ mol−1 . What are (a) the entropy of activation, (b) the enthalpy of activation, (c) the Gibbs energy of activation at 298 K? 24.15a The rate constant of the reaction H2O2(aq) + I− (aq) + H+ (aq) → H2O(l) + HIO(aq) is sensitive to the ionic strength of the aqueous solution in which the reaction occurs. At 25°C, k = 12.2 dm6 mol−2 min−1 at an ionic strength of 0.0525. Use the Debye–Hückel limiting law to estimate the rate constant at zero ionic strength. 24.15b At 25°C, k = 1.55 dm6 mol−2 min−1 at an ionic strength of 0.0241 for a reaction in which the rate-determining step involves the encounter of two singly charged cations. Use the Debye–Hückel limiting law to estimate the rate constant at zero ionic strength. 24.16a For a pair of electron donor and acceptor, HAB = 0.03 cm−1 , ∆rG7 = −0.182 eV and ket = 30.5 s−1 at 298 K. Estimate the value of the reorganization energy. 24.16b For a pair of electron donor and acceptor, ket = 2.02 × 105 s−1 for ∆rG7 = −0.665 eV. The standard reaction Gibbs energy changes to ∆rG7 = −0.975 eV when a substituent is added to the electron acceptor and the rate constant for electron transfer changes to ket = 3.33 × 106 s−1 . The experiments were conducted at 298 K. Assuming that the distance between donor and acceptor is the same in both experiments, estimate the values of HAB and λ. 24.17a For a pair of electron donor and acceptor, ket = 2.02 × 105 s−1 when r = 1.11 nm and ket = 4.51 × 105 s−1 when r = 1.23 nm. Assuming that ∆rG7 and λ are the same in both experiments, estimate the value of β. 24.17b Refer to Exercise 24.17a. Estimate the value of ket when r = 1.48 nm. Problems* Numerical problems 24.1 In the dimerization of methyl radicals at 25°C, the experimental preexponential factor is 2.4 × 1010 dm3 mol−1 s−1 . What are (a) the reactive crosssection, (b) the P factor for the reaction if the C-H bond length is 154 pm? 24.2 Nitrogen dioxide reacts bimolecularly in the gas phase to give 2 NO + O2. The temperature dependence of the second-order rate constant for the rate law d[P]/dt = k[NO2]2 is given below. What are the P factor and the reactive cross-section for the reaction? * Problems denoted with the symbol ‡ were supplied by Charles Trapp, Carmen Giunta, and Marshall Cady. 24.9‡ For the thermal decomposition of F2O by the reaction 2 F2O(g) → 2 F2(g) + O2(g), J. Czarnowski and H.J. Schuhmacher (Chem. Phys. Lett. 17, 235 (1972)) have suggested the following mechanism: (1) F2O + F2O → F + OF + F2O k1 (2) F + F2O → F2 + OF k2 (3) OF + OF → O2 + F + F k3 (4) F + F + F2O → F2 + F2O k4 (a) Using the steady-state approximation, show that this mechanism is consistent with the experimental rate law −d[F2O]/dt = k[F2O]2 + k′[F2O]3/2 . (b) The experimentally determined Arrhenius parameters in the range 501–583 K are A = 7.8 × 1013 dm3 mol−1 s−1 , Ea/R = 1.935 × 104 K for k and and A = 2.3 × 1010 dm3 mol−1 s−1 , Ea/R = 1.691 × 104 K for k′. At 540 K, ∆fH7 (F2O) = +24.41 kJ mol−1 , D(F-F) = 160.6 kJ mol−1 , and D(O-O) = 498.2 kJ mol−1 . Estimate the bond dissociation energies of the first and second F-O bonds and the Arrhenius activation energy of reaction 2. 24.10‡ For the gas-phase reaction A + A → A2, the experimental rate constant, k2, has been fitted to the Arrhenius equation with the preexponential factor A = 4.07 × 105 dm3 mol−1 s−1 at 300 K and an activation energy of 65.43 kJ mol−1 . Calculate ∆‡ S, ∆‡ H, ∆‡ U, and ∆‡ G for the reaction. 24.11‡ One of the most historically significant studies of chemical reaction rates was that by M. Bodenstein (Z. physik. Chem. 29, 295 (1899)) of the gas-phase reaction 2 HI(g) → H2(g) + I2(g) and its reverse, with rate constants k and k′, respectively. The measured rate constants as a function of temperature are T/K 647 666 683 700 716 781 k/(22.4 dm3 mol−1 min−1 ) 0.230 0.588 1.37 3.10 6.70 105.9 k′/(22.4 dm3 mol−1 min−1 ) 0.0140 0.0379 0.0659 0.172 0.375 3.58 Demonstrate that these data are consistent with the collision theory of bimolecular gas-phase reactions. 24.12 Use the approximate form of the Marcus relation (eqn 24.86 with f = 1) to estimate the rate constant for the reaction Ru(bpy)3 3+ + Fe(H2O)6 2+ → Ru(bpy)3 2+ + Fe(H2O)6 3+ , where bpy stands for 4,4′-bipyridine. The following data are useful: Ru(bpy)3 3+ + e− → Ru(bpy)3 2+ E7 = 1.26 V Fe(H2O)6 3+ + e− → Fe(H2O)6 2+ E7 = 0.77 V *Ru(bpy)3 3+ + Ru(bpy)3 2+ → *Ru(bpy)3 2+ + Ru(bpy)3 3+ kRu = 4.0 × 108 dm3 mol−1 s−1 *Fe(H2O)6 3+ + Fe(H2O)6 2+ → *Fe(H2O)6 2+ + Fe(H2O)6 3+ kFe = 4.2 dm3 mol−1 s−1 Theoretical problems 24.13 Confirm that eqn 24.40 is a solution of eqn 24.39, where [J]t is a solution of the same equation but with k = 0 and for the same initial conditions. 24.14 Evaluate [J]* numerically using mathematical software for integration in eqn 24.40, and explore the effect of increasing reaction rate constant on the spatial distribution of J. 24.15 Estimate the orders of magnitude of the partition functions involved in a rate expression. State the order of magnitude of qT m/NA, qR , qV , qE for typical molecules. Check that in the collision of two structureless molecules the order of magnitude of the pre-exponential factor is of the same order as that predicted by collision theory. Go on to estimate the P factor for a reaction in which A + B → P, and A and B are nonlinear triatomic molecules. 24.16 Use the Debye–Hückel limiting law to show that changes in ionic strength can affect the rate of reaction catalysed by H+ from the deprotonation 906 24 MOLECULAR REACTION DYNAMICS T/K 600 700 800 1000 k/(cm3 mol−1 s−1 ) 4.6 × 102 9.7 × 103 1.3 × 105 3.1 × 106 Take σ = 0.60 nm2 . 24.3 The diameter of the methyl radical is about 308 pm. What is the maximum rate constant in the expression d[C2H6]/dt = k[CH3]2 for secondorder recombination of radicals at room temperature? 10 per cent of a 1.0- dm3 sample of ethane at 298 K and 100 kPa is dissociated into methyl radicals. What is the minimum time for 90 per cent recombination? 24.4 The rates of thermolysis of a variety of cis- and trans-azoalkanes have been measured over a range of temperatures in order to settle a controversy concerning the mechanism of the reaction. In ethanol an unstable cisazoalkane decomposed at a rate that was followed by observing the N2 evolution, and this led to the rate constants listed below (P.S. Engel and D.J. Bishop, J. Amer. Chem. Soc. 97, 6754 (1975)). Calculate the enthalpy, entropy, energy, and Gibbs energy of activation at –20°C. θ/°C −24.82 −20.73 −17.02 −13.00 −8.95 104 × k/s−1 1.22 2.31 4.39 8.50 14.3 24.5 In an experimental study of a bimolecular reaction in aqueous solution, the second-order rate constant was measured at 25°C and at a variety of ionic strengths and the results are tabulated below. It is known that a singly charged ion is involved in the rate-determining step. What is the charge on the other ion involved? I 0.0025 0.0037 0.0045 0.0065 0.0085 k/(dm3 mol−1 s−1 ) 1.05 1.12 1.16 1.18 1.26 24.6 The rate constant of the reaction I− (aq) + H2O2(aq) → H2O(l) + IO− (aq) varies slowly with ionic strength, even though the Debye–Hückel limiting law predicts no effect. Use the following data from 25°C to find the dependence of log kr on the ionic strength: I/(mol kg−1 ) 0.0207 0.0525 0.0925 0.1575 kr/(dm3 mol−1 min−1 ) 0.663 0.670 0.679 0.694 Evaluate the limiting value of kr at zero ionic strength. What does the result suggest for the dependence of log γ on ionic strength for a neutral molecule in an electrolyte solution? 24.7 The total cross-sections for reactions between alkali metal atoms and halogen molecules are given in the table below (R.D. Levine and R.B. Bernstein, Molecular reaction dynamics, Clarendon Press, Oxford, 72 (1974)). Assess the data in terms of the harpoon mechanism. σ*/nm2 Cl2 Br2 I2 Na 1.24 1.16 0.97 K 1.54 1.51 1.27 Rb 1.90 1.97 1.67 Cs 1.96 2.04 1.95 Electron affinities are approximately 1.3 eV (Cl2), 1.2 eV (Br2), and 1.7 eV (I2), and ionization energies are 5.1 eV (Na), 4.3 eV (K), 4.2 eV (Rb), and 3.9 eV (Cs). 24.8‡ M. Cyfert, B. Latko, and M. Wawrzeczyk (Int. J. Chem. Kinet. 28, 103 (1996)) examined the oxidation of tris(1,10-phenanthroline)iron(II) by periodate in aqueous solution, a reaction that shows autocatalytic behaviour. To assess the kinetic salt effect, they measured rate constants at a variety of concentrations of Na2SO4 far in excess of reactant concentrations and reported the following data: [Na2SO4]/(mol kg−1 ) 0.2 0.15 0.1 0.05 0.25 0.0125 0.005 k/(dm3/2 mol−1/2 s−1 ) 0.462 0.430 0.390 0.321 0.283 0.252 0.224 What can be inferred about the charge of the activated complex of the ratedetermining step? PROBLEMS 907 of a weak acid. Consider the mechanism: H+ (aq) + B(aq) → P, where H+ comes from the deprotonation of the weak acid, HA. The weak acid has a fixed concentration. First show that log [H+ ], derived from the ionization of HA, depends on the activity coefficients of ions and thus depends on the ionic strength. Then find the relationship between log(rate) and log [H+ ] to show that the rate also depends on the ionic strength. 24.17 The Eyring equation can also be applied to physical processes. As an example, consider the rate of diffusion of an atom stuck to the surface of a solid. Suppose that in order to move from one site to another it has to reach the top of the barrier where it can vibrate classically in the vertical direction and in one horizontal direction, but vibration along the other horizontal direction takes it into the neighbouring site. Find an expression for the rate of diffusion, and evaluate it for W atoms on a tungsten surface (Ea = 60 kJ mol−1 ). Suppose that the vibration frequencies at the transition state are (a) the same as, (b) one-half the value for the adsorbed atom. What is the value of the diffusion coefficient D at 500 K? (Take the site separation as 316 pm and ν = 1 × 1011 Hz.) 24.18 Suppose now that the adsorbed, migrating species treated in Problem 24.17 is a spherical molecule, and that it can rotate classically as well as vibrate at the top of the barrier, but that at the adsorption site itself it can only vibrate. What effect does this have on the diffusion constant? Take the molecule to be methane, for which B = 5.24 cm−1 . 24.19 Show that the intensities of a molecular beam before and after passing through a chamber of length l containing inert scattering atoms are related by I = I0e−Nσl , where σ is the collision cross-section and N the number density of scattering atoms. 24.20 In a molecular beam experiment to measure collision cross-sections it was found that the intensity of a CsCl beam was reduced to 60 per cent of its intensity on passage through CH2F2 at 10 µTorr, but that when the target was Ar at the same pressure the intensity was reduced only by 10 per cent. What are the relative cross-sections of the two types of collision? Why is one much larger than the other? 24.21‡ Show that bimolecular reactions between nonlinear molecules are much slower than between atoms even when the activation energies of both reactions are equal. Use transition state theory and make the following assumptions. (1) All vibrational partition functions are close to unity; (2) all rotational partition functions are approximately 1 × 101.5 , which is a reasonable order of magnitude number; (3) the translational partition function for each species is 1 × 1026 . 24.22 This exercise gives some familiarity with the difficulties involved in predicting the structure of activated complexes. It also demonstrates the importance of femtosecond spectroscopy to our understanding of chemical dynamics because direct experimental observation of the activated complex removes much of the ambiguity of theoretical predictions. Consider the attack of H on D2, which is one step in the H2 + D2 reaction. (a) Suppose that the H approaches D2 from the side and forms a complex in the form of an isosceles triangle. Take the H-D distance as 30 per cent greater than in H2 (74 pm) and the D-D distance as 20 per cent greater than in H2. Let the critical coordinate be the antisymmetric stretching vibration in which one H-D bond stretches as the other shortens. Let all the vibrations be at about 1000 cm−1 . Estimate k2 for this reaction at 400 K using the experimental activation energy of about 35 kJ mol−1 . (b) Now change the model of the activated complex in part (a) and make it linear. Use the same estimated molecular bond lengths and vibrational frequencies to calculate k2 for this choice of model. (c) Clearly, there is much scope for modifying the parameters of the models of the activated complex. Use mathematical software or write and run a program that allows you to vary the structure of the complex and the parameters in a plausible way, and look for a model (or more than one model) that gives a value of k close to the experimental value, 4 × 105 dm3 mol−1 s−1 . Applications: to environmental science and biochemistry 24.23‡ R. Atkinson (J. Phys. Chem. Ref. Data 26, 215 (1997)) has reviewed a large set of rate constants relevant to the atmospheric chemistry of volatile organic compounds. The recommended rate constant for the bimolecular association of O2 with an alkyl radical R at 298 K is 4.7 × 109 dm3 mol−1 s−1 for R = C2H5 and 8.4 × 109 dm3 mol−1 s−1 for R = cyclohexyl. Assuming no energy barrier, compute the steric factor, P, for each reaction. (Hint. Obtain collision diameters from collision cross-sections of similar molecules in the Data section.) 24.24‡ The compound α-tocopherol, a form of vitamin E, is a powerful antioxidant that may help to maintain the integrity of biological membranes. R.H. Bisby and A.W. Parker (J. Amer. Chem. Soc. 117, 5664 (1995)) studied the reaction of photochemically excited duroquinone with the antioxidant in ethanol. Once the duroquinone was photochemically excited, a bimolecular reaction took place at a rate described as diffusion-limited. (a) Estimate the rate constant for a diffusion-limited reaction in ethanol. (b) The reported rate constant was 2.77 × 109 dm3 mol−1 s−1 ; estimate the critical reaction distance if the sum of diffusion constants is 1 × 10−9 m2 s−1 . 24.25 The study of conditions that optimize the association of proteins in solution guides the design of protocols for formation of large crystals that are amenable to analysis by the X-ray diffraction techniques discussed in Chapter 20. It is important to characterize protein dimerization because the process is considered to be the rate-determining step in the growth of crystals of many proteins. Consider the variation with ionic strength of the rate constant of dimerization in aqueous solution of a cationic protein P: I 0.0100 0.0150 0.0200 0.0250 0.0300 0.0350 k/k° 8.10 13.30 20.50 27.80 38.10 52.00 What can be deduced about the charge of P? 24.26 A useful strategy for the study of electron transfer in proteins consists of attaching an electroactive species to the protein’s surface and then measuring ket between the attached species and an electroactive protein cofactor. J.W. Winkler and H.B. Gray (Chem. Rev. 92, 369 (1992)) summarize data for cytochrome c (Impact I7.2) modified by replacement of the haem iron by a zinc ion, resulting in a zinc-porphyrin (ZnP) moiety in the interior of the protein, and by attachment of a ruthenium ion complex to a surface histidine aminoacid. The edge-to-edge distance between the electroactive species was thus fixed at 1.23 nm. A variety of ruthenium ion complexes with different standard reduction potentials were used. For each ruthenium-modified protein, either the Ru2+ → ZnP+ or the ZnP* → Ru3+ , in which the electron donor is an electronic excited state of the zinc-porphyrin formed by laser excitation, was monitored. This arrangement leads to different standard reaction Gibbs energies because the redox couples ZnP+ /ZnP and ZnP+ /ZnP* have different standard potentials, with the electronically excited porphyrin being a more powerful reductant. Use the following data to estimate the reorganization energy for this system: −∆rG7 /eV 0.665 0.705 0.745 0.975 1.015 1.055 ket/(106 s−1 ) 0.657 1.52 1.12 8.99 5.76 10.1 24.27 The photosynthetic reaction centre of the purple photosynthetic bacterium Rhodopseudomonas viridis contains a number of bound cofactors that participate in electron transfer reactions. The following table shows data compiled by Moser et al. (Nature 355, 796 (1992)) on the rate constants for electron transfer between different cofactors and their edge-to-edge distances: Reaction BChl− → BPh BPh− → BChl2 + BPh− → QA cyt c559 → BChl2 + r/nm 0.48 0.95 0.96 1.23 ket/s−1 1.58 × 1012 3.98 × 109 1.00 × 109 1.58 × 108 Reaction QA − → QB QA − → BChl2 + r/nm 1.35 2.24 ket/s−1 3.98 × 107 63.1 908 24 MOLECULAR REACTION DYNAMICS (BChl, bacteriochlorophyll; BChl2, bacteriochlorophyll dimer, functionally distinct from BChl; BPh, bacteriophaeophytin; QA and QB, quinone molecules bound to two distinct sites; cyt c559, a cytochrome bound to the reaction centre complex). Are these data in agreement with the behaviour predicted by eqn 24.83? If so, evaluate the value of β. 24.28 The rate constant for electron transfer between a cytochrome c and the bacteriochlorophyll dimer of the reaction centre of the purple bacterium Rhodobacter sphaeroides (Problem 24.27) decreases with decreasing temperature in the range 300 K to 130 K. Below 130 K, the rate constant becomes independent of temperature. Account for these results. 24.29 Azurin is a protein containing a copper ion that shuttles between the +2 and +1 oxidation states, and cytochrome c is a protein in which a haem-bound iron ion shuttles between the +3 and +2 oxidation states. The rate constant for electron transfer from reduced azurin to oxidized cytochrome c is 1.6 × 103 dm3 mol−1 s−1 . Estimate the electron self-exchange rate constant for azurin from the following data: kii /(dm3 mol−1 s−1 ) E7 /V cytochrome c 1.5 × 102 0.260 azurin ? 0.304 Processes at solid surfaces In this chapter we see how solids grow at their surfaces and how the details of the structure and composition of solid surfaces can be determined experimentally. A major part of the material concerns the extent to which a surface is covered and the variation of the extent of coverage with the pressure and temperature. This material is used to discuss how surfaces affect the rate and course of chemical change by acting as the site of catalysis. Reactions at surfaces include the processes that lie at the heart of electrochemistry. Therefore, we revisit in this chapter some of the topics treated in Chapter 7, but focus on the dynamics of electrode processes rather than the equilibrium properties treated there. Finally, we analyse the kinetics of reactions that are responsible for power production in fuel cells and for corrosion. Processes at solid surfaces govern the viability of industry both constructively, as in catalysis, and destructively, as in corrosion. Chemical reactions at solid surfaces may differ sharply from reactions in the bulk, for reaction pathways of much lower activation energy may be provided, and hence result in catalysis. The concept of a solid surface has been extended in recent years with the availability of microporous materials as catalysts. An important kinetic problem examined in this chapter is the rate at which oxidizable or reducible species—in short, electroactive species—can donate or accept electrons on the surfaces of electrodes. In Chapter 24 we explored the dynamics of electron transfer in homogeneous systems. In heterogeneous systems, the rates of processes that occur at the interface between the phases, such as an electrode immersed in an ionic solution, are very important. A measure of this rate is the current density, j, the charge flux through a region (the electric current divided by the area of the region). We shall discuss the properties that control the current density and its consequences. We shall see that acronyms are widely used in surface studies; for convenience, a list of the acronyms used in this chapter is given in Table 25.7 at the end of the chapter. The growth and structure of solid surfaces In this section we see how surfaces are extended and crystals grow. The attachment of particles to a surface is called adsorption. The substance that adsorbs is the adsorbate and the underlying material that we are concerned with in this section is the adsorbent or substrate. The reverse of adsorption is desorption. 25 The growth and structure of solid surfaces 25.1 Surface growth 25.2 Surface composition The extent of adsorption 25.3 Physisorption and chemisorption 25.4 Adsorption isotherms 25.5 The rates of surface processes I25.1 Impact on biochemistry: Biosensor analysis Heterogeneous catalysis 25.6 Mechanisms of heterogeneous catalysis 25.7 Catalytic activity at surfaces I25.2 Impact on technology: Examples of catalysis in the chemical industry Processes at electrodes 25.8 The electrode–solution interface 25.9 The rate of charge transfer 25.10 Voltammetry 25.11 Electrolysis 25.12 Working galvanic cells I25.3 Impactontechnology:Fuelcells 25.13 Corrosion I25.4 Impact on technology: Protecting materials against corrosion Checklist of key ideas Further reading Further information 25.1: The relation between electrode potential and the Galvani potential Discussion questions Exercises Problems 910 25 PROCESSES AT SOLID SURFACES 25.1 Surface growth A simple picture of a perfect crystal surface is as a tray of oranges in a grocery store (Fig. 25.1). A gas molecule that collides with the surface can be imagined as a ping-pong ball bouncing erratically over the oranges. The molecule loses energy as it bounces, but it is likely to escape from the surface before it has lost enough kinetic energy to be trapped. The same is true, to some extent, of an ionic crystal in contact with a solution. There is little energy advantage for an ion in solution to discard some of its solvating molecules and stick at an exposed position on the surface. The picture changes when the surface has defects, for then there are ridges of incomplete layers of atoms or ions. A common type of surface defect is a step between two otherwise flat layers of atoms called terraces (Fig. 25.2). A step defect might itself have defects, for it might have kinks. When an atom settles on a terrace it bounces across it under the influence of the intermolecular potential, and might come to a step or a corner formed by a kink. Instead of interacting with a single terrace atom, the molecule now interacts with several, and the interaction may be strong enough to trap it. Likewise, when ions deposit from solution, the loss of the solvation interaction is offset by a strong Coulombic interaction between the arriving ions and several ions at the surface defect. Not all kinds of defect result in sustained surface growth. As the process of settling into ledges and kinks continues, there comes a stage when an entire lower terrace has been covered. At this stage the surface defects have been eliminated, and growth will cease. For continuing growth, a surface defect is needed that propagates as the crystal grows. We can see what form of defect this must be by considering the types of dislocations, or discontinuities in the regularity of the lattice, that exist in the bulk of a crystal. One reason for their formation may be that the crystal grows so quickly that its particles do not have time to settle into states of lowest potential energy before being trapped in position by the deposition of the next layer. A special kind of dislocation is the screw dislocation shown in Fig. 25.3. Imagine a cut in the crystal, with the atoms to the left of the cut pushed up through a distance of one unit cell. The unit cells now form a continuous spiral around the end of the cut, which is called the screw axis. A path encircling the screw axis spirals up to the top of the crystal, and where the dislocation breaks through to the surface it takes the form of a spiral ramp. The surface defect formed by a screw dislocation is a step, possibly with kinks, where growth can occur. The incoming particles lie in ranks on the ramp, and successive ranks reform the step at an angle to its initial position. As deposition continues the step rotates around the screw axis and is not eliminated. Growth may therefore continue indefinitely. Several layers of deposition may occur, and the edges of the spirals might be cliffs several atoms high. Propagating spiral edges can also give rise to flat terraces (Fig. 25.4). Terraces are formed if growth occurs simultaneously at neighbouring left- and right-handed screw dislocations (Fig. 25.5). Successive tables of atoms may form as counter-rotating defects collide on successive circuits, and the terraces formed may then fill up by further deposition at their edges to give flat crystal planes. The rapidity of growth depends on the crystal plane concerned, and the slowest growing faces dominate the appearance of the crystal. This feature is explained in Fig. 25.6, where we see that, although the horizontal face grows forward most rapidly, it grows itself out of existence, and the slower-growing faces survive. Fig. 25.1 A schematic diagram of the flat surface of a solid. This primitive model is largely supported by scanning tunnelling microscope images (see Impact I9.1). Fig. 25.2 Some of the kinds of defects that may occur on otherwise perfect terraces. Defects play an important role in surface growth and catalysis. 25.2 SURFACE COMPOSITION 911 25.2 Surface composition Under normal conditions, a surface exposed to a gas is constantly bombarded with molecules and a freshly prepared surface is covered very quickly. Just how quickly can be estimated using the kinetic model of gases and the expression (eqn 21.14) for the collision flux: ZW = (25.1a) A practical form of this equation is ZW = with Z0 = 2.63 × 1024 m−2 s−1 (25.1b) where M is the molar mass of the gas. For air (M ≈ 29 g mol−1 ) at 1 atm and 25°C the collision flux is 3 × 1027 m−2 s−1 . Because 1 m2 of metal surface consists of about 1019 atoms, each atom is struck about 108 times each second. Even if only a few collisions leave a molecule adsorbed to the surface, the time for which a freshly prepared surface remains clean is very short. The obvious way to retain cleanliness is to reduce the pressure. When it is reduced to 10−4 Pa (as in a simple vacuum system) the collision flux falls to about 1018 m−2 s−1 , corresponding to one hit per surface atom in each 0.1 s. Even that is too brief in most experiments, and in ultrahigh vacuum (UHV) techniques pressures as low as 10−7 Pa (when ZW = 1015 m−2 s−1 ) are reached on a routine basis and as low as 10−9 Pa (when ZW = 1013 m−2 s−1 ) are reached with special care. These collision fluxes correspond to each surface atom being hit once every 105 to 106 s, or about once a day. The layout of a typical UHV apparatus is such that the whole of the evacuated part can be heated to 150–250°C for several hours to drive gas molecules from the walls. All the taps and seals are usually of metal so as to avoid contamination from greases. The sample is usually in the form of a thin foil, a filament, or a sharp point. Where there is interest in the role of specific crystal planes the sample is a single crystal with a freshly cleaved face. Initial surface cleaning is achieved either by heating it electrically or by Z0(p/Pa) {(T/K)(M/(g mol−1 )}1/2 p (2πmkT)1/2 Fig. 25.3 A screw dislocation occurs where one region of the crystal is pushed up through one or more unit cells relative to another region. The cut extends to the screw axis. As atoms lie along the step the dislocation rotates round the screw axis and is not annihilated. Fig. 25.4 The spiral growth pattern is sometimes concealed because the terraces are subsequently completed by further deposition. This accounts for the appearance of this cadmium iodide crystal. (H.M. Rosenberg, The solid state. Clarendon Press, Oxford (1978).) Fig. 25.5 Counter-rotating screw dislocations on the same surface lead to the formation of terraces. Four stages of one cycle of growth are shown here. Subsequent deposition can complete each terrace. Fig. 25.6 The slower-growing faces of a crystal dominate its final external appearance. Three successive stages of the growth are shown. 912 25 PROCESSES AT SOLID SURFACES bombarding it with accelerated gaseous ions. The latter procedure demands care because ion bombardment can shatter the surface structure and leave it an amorphous jumble of atoms. High temperature annealing is then required to return the surface to an ordered state. We have already discussed three important techniques for the characterization of surfaces: scanning electron microscopy (Impact I8.1), which is often used to observe terraces, steps, kinks, and dislocations on a surface, and scanning probe microscopy (Impact I9.1), which reveals the atomic details of structure of the surface and of adsorbates and can be used to visualize chemical reactions as they happen on surfaces (Fig. 25.7). In the following sections, we describe additional techniques that comprise the toolbox of a surface scientist. (a) Ionization techniques Surface composition can be determined by a variety of ionization techniques. The same techniques can be used to detect any remaining contamination after cleaning and to detect layers of material adsorbed later in the experiment. Their common feature is thattheescapedepthoftheelectrons,themaximumdepthfromwhichejectedelectrons come, is in the range 0.1–1.0 nm, which ensures that only surface species contribute. One technique that may be used is photoelectron spectroscopy (Section 11.4), which in surface studies is normally called photoemission spectroscopy. X-rays or hard ultraviolet ionizing radiation of energy in the range 5–40 eV may be used, giving rise to the techniques denoted XPS and UPS, respectively. In XPS, the energy of the incident photon is so great that electrons are ejected from inner cores of atoms. As a first approximation, core ionization energies are insensitive to the bonds between atoms because they are too tightly bound to be greatly affected by the changes that accompany bond formation, so core ionization energies are characteristic of the individual atom. Consequently, XPS gives lines characteristic of the elements present on a surface. For instance, the K-shell ionization energies of the second row elements are Li Be B C N O F 50 110 190 280 400 530 690 eV Detection of one of these values (and values corresponding to ejection from other inner shells) indicates the presence of the corresponding element (Fig. 25.8). This Fig. 25.7 Visualization by STM of the reaction SiH3 → SiH2 + H on a 4.7 nm × 4.7 nm area of a Si(001) surface. (a) The Si(001) surface before exposure to Si2H6(g). (b) Adsorbed Si2H6 dissociates into SiH2(surface), on the left of the image, and SiH3(surface), on the right. (c) After 8 min, SiH3(surface) dissociates to SiH2(surface) and H(surface). (Reproduced with permission from Y. Wang, M.J. Bronikowski, and R.J. Hamers, Surface Science 64, 311 (1994).) Fig. 25.8 The X-ray photoelectron emission spectrum of a sample of gold contaminated with a surface layer of mercury. (M.W. Roberts and C.S. McKee, Chemistry of the metal–gas interface, Oxford (1978).) 25.2 SURFACE COMPOSITION 913 application is responsible for the alternative name electron spectroscopy for chemical analysis (ESCA). The technique is very useful for studying the surface state of heterogeneous catalysts, the differences between surface and bulk structures, and the processes that can cause damage to high-temperature superconductors and semiconductor wafers. UPS, which examines electrons ejected from valence shells, is more suited to establishing the bonding characteristics and the details of valence shell electronic structures of substances on the surface. Its usefulness is its ability to reveal which orbitals of the adsorbate are involved in the bond to the substrate. For instance, the principal difference between the photoemission results on free benzene and benzene adsorbed on palladium is in the energies of the π electrons. This difference is interpreted as meaning that the C6H6 molecules lie parallel to the surface and are attached to it by their π orbitals. In secondary-ion mass spectrometry (SIMS), the surface is ionized by bombardment with other ions and the secondary ions that emerge from the surface are detected by a mass spectrometer. Among the advantages of SIMS are the ability to detect adsorbed H and He atoms, which are not easily probed by XPS, and the high sensitivity of the mass spectrometer detector. A disadvantage is that SIMS analysis erodes the part of the sample that is bombarded. However, it is possible to control the degree of erosion to one or two monolayers by controlling the bombardment parameters. (b) Vibrational spectroscopy Several kinds of vibrational spectroscopy have been developed to study adsorbates and to show whether dissociation has occurred. Measurement of transmitted radiation is not practical in surfaces, which are typically too opaque to infrared or visible radiation. One technique that circumvents this problem is reflection–absorption infrared spectroscopy (RAIRS), in which the Fourier-transform IR absorption spectrum of the adsorbate is obtained by comparing the intensity of the incident infrared beam with the intensity of infrared radiation reflected by the surface. Raman spectroscopy is better suited for studies of surfaces because it involves the detection of scattered radiation, but spectral bands are typically very weak. However, surface-enhanced Raman scattering (SERS) is viable for surface studies: the strong enhancement of the Raman spectrum of the adsorbate can increase intensities by a factor as big as 106 . The effect is due in part to local accumulations of electron density at the features of the roughened surface and at regions where bonding occurs. The SERS effect is also observed when molecules adsorb to colloidal particles of gold and silver, with the surface of the colloid fostering the enhancement of the Raman spectrum. Disadvantages of SERS include weak enhancement observed on flat single crystal surfaces and the fact that the technique works for only certain metals. (c) Electron spectroscopy A hybrid version of photoemission spectroscopy and vibrational spectroscopy is electron energy loss spectroscopy (EELS, or HREELS, where HR denotes high resolution) in which the energy loss suffered by a beam of electrons is monitored when they are reflected from a surface. As in Raman spectroscopy, the spectrum of energy loss can be interpreted in terms of the vibrational spectrum of the adsorbate. High resolution and sensitivity are attainable, and the technique is sensitive to light elements (to which X-ray techniques are insensitive). Very tiny amounts of adsorbate can be detected, and one report estimated that about 48 atoms of phosphorus were detected in one sample. As an example, Fig. 25.9 shows the EELS result for CO on the (111) face of a platinum crystal as the extent of surface coverage increases. The main peak arises Fig. 25.9 The electron energy loss spectrum of CO adsorbed on Pt(111). The results for three different pressures are shown, and the growth of the additional peak at about 200 meV (1600 cm−1 ) should be noted. (Based on spectra provided by Professor H. Ibach.) 914 25 PROCESSES AT SOLID SURFACES from CO attached perpendicular to the surface by a single Pt atom. As the coverage increases the neighbouring smaller peak increases in intensity. This peak is due to CO at a bridge site, attached to two Pt atoms, as in (1). A very important technique, which is widely used in the microelectronics industry, is Auger electron spectroscopy (AES). The Auger effect is the emission of a second electron after high energy radiation has expelled another. The first electron to depart leaves a hole in a low-lying orbital, and an upper electron falls into it. The energy this releases may result either in the generation of radiation, which is called X-ray fluorescence (Fig. 25.10a) or in the ejection of another electron (Fig. 25.10b). The latter is the secondary electron of the Auger effect. The energies of the secondary electrons are characteristic of the material present, so the Auger effect effectively takes a fingerprint of the sample. In practice, the Auger spectrum is normally obtained by irradiating the sample with an electron beam of energy in the range 1–5 keV rather than electromagnetic radiation. In scanning Auger electron microscopy (SAM), the finely focused electron beam is scanned over the surface and a map of composition is compiled; the resolution can reach below about 50 nm. (d) Surface-extended X-ray absorption fine structure spectroscopy The technique known as surface-extended X-ray absorption fine structure spectroscopy (SEXAFS) uses intense X-radiation from synchrotron sources (Further information 13.1). Oscillations in X-ray absorbance are observed on the high-frequency side of the absorption edge (the start of an X-ray absorption band) of a substance. These oscillations arise from a quantum mechanical interference between the wavefunction of a photoejected electron and parts of that electron’s wavefunction that are scattered by neighbouring atoms. If the waves interfere destructively, then the photoelectron appears with lower probability and the X-ray absorption is correspondingly less. If the waves interfere constructively, then the photoelectron amplitude is higher, and the photoelectron has a higher probability of appearing; correspondingly, the X-ray absorption is greater. The oscillations therefore contain information about the number and distances of the neighbouring atoms. Such studies show that a solid’s surface is much more plastic than had previously been thought, and that it undergoes reconstruction, or structural modification, in response to adsorbates that are present. (e) Low-energy electron diffraction One of the most informative techniques for determining the arrangement of the atoms close to the surface is low energy electron diffraction (LEED). This technique is like X-ray diffraction (Chapter 20) but uses the wave character of electrons, and the sample is now the surface of a solid. The use of low energy electrons (with energies in the range 10–200 eV, corresponding to wavelengths in the range 100–400 pm) ensures that the diffraction is caused only by atoms on and close to the surface. The experimental arrangement is shown in Fig. 25.11, and typical LEED patterns, obtained by photographing the fluorescent screen through the viewing port, are shown in Fig. 25.12. A LEED pattern portrays the two-dimensional structure of the surface. By studying how the diffraction intensities depend on the energy of the electron beam it is also possible to infer some details about the vertical location of the atoms and to measure the thickness of the surface layer, but the interpretation of LEED data is much more complicated than the interpretation of bulk X-ray data. The pattern is sharp if the surface is well-ordered for distances long compared with the wavelength of the incident electrons. In practice, sharp patterns are obtained for surfaces ordered to depths of about 20 nm and more. Diffuse patterns indicate either a poorly ordered surface or the presence of impurities. If the LEED pattern does not correspond to the pattern Fig. 25.11 A schematic diagram of the apparatus used for a LEED experiment. The electrons diffracted by the surface layers are detected by the fluorescence they cause on the phosphor screen. Fig. 25.10 When an electron is expelled from a solid (a) an electron of higher energy may fall into the vacated orbital and emit an X-ray photon to produce X-ray fluorescence. Alternatively, (b) the electron falling into the orbital may give up its energy to another electron, which is ejected in the Auger effect. 25.2 SURFACE COMPOSITION 915 Fig. 25.12 LEED photographs of (a) a clean platinum surface and (b) after its exposure to propyne, CH3C.CH. (Photographs provided by Professor G.A. Somorjai.) Fig. 25.13 The structure of a surface close to the point of attachment of CH3C- to the (110) surface of rhodium at 300 K and the changes in positions of the metal atoms that accompany chemisorption. Fig. 25.14 LEED patterns may be used to assess the defect density of a surface. The photographs correspond to a platinum surface with (top) low defect density, (middle) regular steps separated by about six atoms, and (bottom) regular steps with kinks. (Photographs provided by Professor G.A. Samorjai.) expected by extrapolation of the bulk surface to the surface, then either a reconstruction of the surface has occurred or there is order in the arrangement of an adsorbed layer. The results of LEED experiments show that the surface of a crystal rarely has exactly the same form as a slice through the bulk. As a general rule, it is found that metal surfaces are simply truncations of the bulk lattice, but the distance between the top layer of atoms and the one below is contracted by around 5 per cent. Semiconductors generally have surfaces reconstructed to a depth of several layers. Reconstruction occurs in ionic solids. For example, in lithium fluoride the Li+ and F− ions close to the surface apparently lie on slightly different planes. An actual example of the detail that can now be obtained from refined LEED techniques is shown in Fig. 25.13 for CH3C- adsorbed on a (111) plane of rhodium. The presence of terraces, steps, and kinks in a surface shows up in LEED patterns, and their surface density (the number of defects in a region divided by the area of the region) can be estimated. The importance of this type of measurement will emerge later. Three examples of how steps and kinks affect the pattern are shown in Fig. 25.14. The samples used were obtained by cleaving a crystal at different angles to a plane of 916 25 PROCESSES AT SOLID SURFACES atoms. Only terraces are produced when the cut is parallel to the plane, and the density of steps increases as the angle of the cut increases. The observation of additional structure in the LEED patterns, rather than blurring, shows that the steps are arrayed regularly. (f) Molecular beam techniques Whereas many important studies have been carried out simply by exposing a surface to a gas, modern work is increasingly making use of molecularbeamscattering (MBS). One advantage is that the activity of specific crystal planes can be investigated by directing the beam on to an orientated surface with known step and kink densities (as measured by LEED). Furthermore, if the adsorbate reacts at the surface the products (and their angular distributions) can be analysed as they are ejected from the surface and pass into a mass spectrometer. Another advantage is that the time of flight of a particle may be measured and interpreted in terms of its residence time on the surface. In this way a very detailed picture can be constructed of the events taking place during reactions at surfaces. The extent of adsorption The extent of surface coverage is normally expressed as the fractional coverage, θ: θ = [25.2] The fractional coverage is often expressed in terms of the volume of adsorbate adsorbed by θ = V/V∞, where V∞ is the volume of adsorbate corresponding to complete monolayer coverage. The rateofadsorption, dθ/dt, is the rate of change of surface coverage, and can be determined by observing the change of fractional coverage with time. Among the principal techniques for measuring dθ/dt are flow methods, in which the sample itself acts as a pump because adsorption removes particles from the gas. One commonly used technique is therefore to monitor the rates of flow of gas into and out of the system: the difference is the rate of gas uptake by the sample. Integration of this rate then gives the fractional coverage at any stage. In flash desorption the sample is suddenly heated (electrically) and the resulting rise of pressure is interpreted in terms of the amount of adsorbate originally on the sample. The interpretation may be confused by the desorption of a compound (for example, WO3 from oxygen on tungsten). Gravimetry, in which the sample is weighed on a microbalance during the experiment, can also be used. A common instrument for gravimetric measurements is the quartz crystal microbalance (QCM), in which the mass of a sample laid on the surface of a quartz crystal is related to changes in the latter’s mechanical properties. The key principle behind the operation of a QCM is the ability of a quartz crystal to vibrate at a characteristic frequency when an oscillating electric field is applied. The vibrational frequency decreases when material is spread over the surface of the crystal and the change in frequency is proportional to the mass of material. Masses as small as a few nanograms (1 ng = 10−9 g) can be measured reliably in this way. 25.3 Physisorption and chemisorption Molecules and atoms can attach to surfaces in two ways. In physisorption (an abbreviation of ‘physical adsorption’), there is a van der Waals interaction (for example, a dispersion or a dipolar interaction) between the adsorbate and the substrate. Van der Waals interactions have a long range but are weak, and the energy released when a number of adsorption sites occupied number of adsorption sites available 25.4 ADSORPTION ISOTHERMS 917 particle is physisorbed is of the same order of magnitude as the enthalpy of condensation. Such small energies can be absorbed as vibrations of the lattice and dissipated as thermal motion, and a molecule bouncing across the surface will gradually lose its energy and finally adsorb to it in the process called accommodation. The enthalpy of physisorption can be measured by monitoring the rise in temperature of a sample of known heat capacity, and typical values are in the region of 20 kJ mol−1 (Table 25.1). This small enthalpy change is insufficient to lead to bond breaking, so a physisorbed molecule retains its identity, although it might be distorted by the presence of the surface. In chemisorption (an abbreviation of ‘chemical adsorption’), the molecules (or atoms) stick to the surface by forming a chemical (usually covalent) bond, and tend to find sites that maximize their coordination number with the substrate. The enthalpy of chemisorption is very much greater than that for physisorption, and typical values are in the region of 200 kJ mol−1 (Table 25.2). The distance between the surface and the closest adsorbate atom is also typically shorter for chemisorption than for physisorption. A chemisorbed molecule may be torn apart at the demand of the unsatisfied valencies of the surface atoms, and the existence of molecular fragments on the surface as a result of chemisorption is one reason why solid surfaces catalyse reactions. Except in special cases, chemisorption must be exothermic. A spontaneous process requires ∆G < 0. Because the translational freedom of the adsorbate is reduced when it is adsorbed, ∆S is negative. Therefore, in order for ∆G = ∆H − T∆S to be negative, ∆H must be negative (that is, the process is exothermic). Exceptions may occur if the adsorbate dissociates and has high translational mobility on the surface. For example, H2 adsorbs endothermically on glass because there is a large increase of translational entropy accompanying the dissociation of the molecules into atoms that move quite freely over the surface. In its case, the entropy change in the process H2(g) → 2 H(glass) is sufficiently positive to overcome the small positive enthalpy change. The enthalpy of adsorption depends on the extent of surface coverage, mainly because the adsorbate particles interact. If the particles repel each other (as for CO on palladium) the adsorption becomes less exothermic (the enthalpy of adsorption less negative) as coverage increases. Moreover, LEED studies show that such species settle on the surface in a disordered way until packing requirements demand order. If the adsorbate particles attract one another (as for O2 on tungsten), then they tend to cluster together in islands, and growth occurs at the borders. These adsorbates also show order–disorder transitions when they are heated enough for thermal motion to overcome the particle–particle interactions, but not so much that they are desorbed. 25.4 Adsorption isotherms The free gas and the adsorbed gas are in dynamic equilibrium, and the fractional coverage of the surface depends on the pressure of the overlying gas. The variation of θ with pressure at a chosen temperature is called the adsorption isotherm. (a) The Langmuir isotherm The simplest physically plausible isotherm is based on three assumptions: 1 Adsorption cannot proceed beyond monolayer coverage. 2 All sites are equivalent and the surface is uniform (that is, the surface is perfectly flat on a microscopic scale). 3 The ability of a molecule to adsorb at a given site is independent of the occupation of neighbouring sites (that is, there are no interactions between adsorbed molecules). Synoptic table 25.1* Maximum observed enthalpies of physisorption Adsorbate DadH7 /(kJ mol−1 ) CH4 −21 H2 −84 H2O −59 N2 −21 * More values are given in the Data section. Synoptic table 25.2* Enthalpies of chemisorption, ∆adH7 /(kJ mol−1 ) Adsorbate Adsorbent (substrate) Cr Fe Ni CH4 −427 −285 −243 CO −192 H2 −188 −134 NH3 −188 −155 * More values are given in the Data section. 918 25 PROCESSES AT SOLID SURFACES Fig. 25.15 The plot of the data in Example 25.1. As illustrated here, the Langmuir isotherm predicts that a straight line should be obtained when p/V is plotted against p. The dynamic equilibrium is A(g) + M(surface) 5 AM(surface) with rate constants ka for adsorption and kd for desorption. The rate of change of surface coverage due to adsorption is proportional to the partial pressure p of A and the number of vacant sites N(1 − θ), where N is the total number of sites: = kapN(1 − θ) (25.3a) The rate of change of θ due to desorption is proportional to the number of adsorbed species, Nθ: = −kdNθ (25.3b) At equilibrium there is no net change (that is, the sum of these two rates is zero), and solving for θ gives the Langmuir isotherm: θ = K = (25.4) Example 25.1 Using the Langmuir isotherm The data given below are for the adsorption of CO on charcoal at 273 K. Confirm that they fit the Langmuir isotherm, and find the constant K and the volume corresponding to complete coverage. In each case V has been corrected to 1.00 atm (101.325 kPa). p/kPa 13.3 26.7 40.0 53.3 66.7 80.0 93.3 V/cm3 10.2 18.6 25.5 31.5 36.9 41.6 46.1 Method From eqn 25.4, Kpθ + θ = Kp With θ = V/V∞, where V∞ is the volume corresponding to complete coverage, this expression can be rearranged into = + Hence, a plot of p/V against p should give a straight line of slope 1/V∞ and intercept 1/KV∞. Answer The data for the plot are as follows: p/kPa 13.3 26.7 40.0 53.3 66.7 80.0 93.3 (p/kPa)/(V/cm3 ) 1.30 1.44 1.57 1.69 1.81 1.92 2.02 The points are plotted in Fig. 25.15. The (least squares) slope is 0.00900, so V∞ = 111 cm3 . The intercept at p = 0 is 1.20, so K = = 7.51 × 10−3 kPa−1 1 (111 cm3 ) × (1.20 kPa cm−3 ) 1 KV∞ p V∞ p V ka kd Kp 1 + Kp dθ dt dθ dt 25.4 ADSORPTION ISOTHERMS 919 Fig. 25.17 The Langmuir isotherm for nondissociative adsorption for different values of K. Exploration Using eqn 25.6, generate a family of curves showing the dependence of 1/θ on 1/p for several valuesof K. Taking these results together with those of the previous Exploration, discuss how plots of 1/θ against 1/p can be used to distinguish between adsorption with and without dissociation. Fig. 25.16 The Langmuir isotherm for dissociative adsorption, X2(g) → 2 X(surface), for different values of K. Exploration Using eqn 25.4, generate a family of curves showing the dependence of 1/θ on 1/p for several valuesof K. Self-test 25.1 Repeat the calculation for the following data: p/kPa 13.3 26.7 40.0 53.3 66.7 80.0 93.3 V/cm3 10.3 19.3 27.3 34.1 40.0 45.5 48.0 [128 cm3 , 6.69 × 10−3 kPa−1 ] For adsorption with dissociation, the rate of adsorption is proportional to the pressure and to the probability that both atoms will find sites, which is proportional to the square of the number of vacant sites, = kap{N(1 − θ)}2 (25.5a) The rate of desorption is proportional to the frequency of encounters of atoms on the surface, and is therefore second-order in the number of atoms present: = −kd(Nθ)2 (25.5b) The condition for no net change leads to the isotherm θ = (25.6) The surface coverage now depends more weakly on pressure than for non-dissociative adsorption. The shapes of the Langmuir isotherms with and without dissociation are shown in Figs. 25.16 and 25.17. The fractional coverage increases with increasing pressure, and approaches 1 only at very high pressure, when the gas is forced on to every available site of the surface. Different curves (and therefore different values of K) are obtained at different temperatures, and the temperature dependence of K can be used to determine the isostericenthalpyofadsorption, ∆adH7 , the standard enthalpy of adsorption at a fixed surface coverage. To determine this quantity we recognize that K is essentially an equilibrium constant, and then use the van ’t Hoff equation (eqn 7.23) to write: θ = (25.7) Example 25.2 Measuring the isosteric enthalpy of adsorption The data below show the pressures of CO needed for the volume of adsorption (corrected to 1.00 atm and 273 K) to be 10.0 cm3 using the same sample as in Example 25.1. Calculate the adsorption enthalpy at this surface coverage. T/K 200 210 220 230 240 250 p/kPa 4.00 4.95 6.03 7.20 8.47 9.85 Method The Langmuir isotherm can be rearranged to Kp = Therefore, when θ is constant, ln K + ln p = constant θ 1 − θ ∆adH7 RT2 D F ∂ ln K ∂T A C (Kp)1/2 1 + (Kp)1/2 dθ dt dθ dt 920 25 PROCESSES AT SOLID SURFACES Fig. 25.18 The isosteric enthalpy of adsorption can be obtained from the slope of the plot of ln p against 1/T, where p is the pressure needed to achieve the specified surface coverage. The data used are from Example 25.2. Fig. 25.19 Plots of the BET isotherm for different values of c. The value of V/Vmon rises indefinitely because the adsorbate may condense on the covered substrate surface. Exploration Using eqn 25.8, generate a family of curves showing the dependence of zVmon/(1 − z)V on z for different values of c. It follows from eqn 25.7 that θ = − θ = − With d(1/T)/dT = −1/T2 , this expression rearranges to θ = Therefore, a plot of ln p against 1/T should be a straight line of slope ∆adH7 /R. Answer We draw up the following table: T/K 200 210 220 230 240 250 103 /(T/K) 5.00 4.76 4.55 4.35 4.17 4.00 ln(p/kPa) 1.39 1.60 1.80 1.97 2.14 2.29 The points are plotted in Fig. 25.18. The slope (of the least squares fitted line) is −0.904, so ∆adH7 = −(0.904 × 103 K) × R = −7.52 kJ mol−1 The value of K can be used to obtain a value of ∆adG7 , and then that value combined with ∆adH7 to obtain the standard entropy of adsorption. The expression for (∂ ln p/∂T)θ in this example is independent of the model for the isotherm. Self-test 25.2 Repeat the calculation using the following data: T/K 200 210 220 230 240 250 p/kPa 4.32 5.59 7.07 8.80 10.67 12.80 [−9.0 kJ mol−1 ] (b) The BET isotherm If the initial adsorbed layer can act as a substrate for further (for example, physical) adsorption, then, instead of the isotherm levelling off to some saturated value at high pressures, it can be expected to rise indefinitely. The most widely used isotherm dealing with multilayer adsorption was derived by Stephen Brunauer, Paul Emmett, and Edward Teller, and is called the BET isotherm: = with z = (25.8) In this expression, p* is the vapour pressure above a layer of adsorbate that is more than one molecule thick and which resembles a pure bulk liquid, Vmon is the volume corresponding to monolayer coverage, and c is a constant which is large when the enthalpy of desorption from a monolayer is large compared with the enthalpy of vaporization of the liquid adsorbate: c = e(∆desH7 −∆vapH7 )/RT (25.9) Figure 25.19 illustrates the shapes of BET isotherms. They rise indefinitely as the pressure is increased because there is no limit to the amount of material that may condense when multilayer coverage may occur. A BET isotherm is not accurate at all pressures, but it is widely used in industry to determine the surface areas of solids. p p* cz (1 − z){1 − (1 − c)z} V Vmon ∆adH7 R D F ∂ ln p ∂(1/T) A C ∆adH7 RT2 D F ∂ ln K ∂T A C D F ∂ ln p ∂T A C 25.4 ADSORPTION ISOTHERMS 921 Fig. 25.20 The BET isotherm can be tested, and the parameters determined, by plotting z/(1 − z)V against z = p/p*. The data are from Example 25.3. Example 25.3 Using the BET isotherm The data below relate to the adsorption of N2 on rutile (TiO2) at 75 K. Confirm that they fit a BET isotherm in the range of pressures reported, and determine Vmon and c. p/kPa 0.160 1.87 6.11 11.67 17.02 21.92 27.29 V/mm3 601 720 822 935 1046 1146 1254 At 75 K, p* = 76.0 kPa. The volumes have been corrected to 1.00 atm and 273 K and refer to 1.00 g of substrate. Method Equation 25.8 can be reorganized into = + It follows that (c − 1)/cVmon can be obtained from the slope of a plot of the expression on the left against z, and cVmon can be found from the intercept at z = 0. The results can then be combined to give c and Vmon. Answer We draw up the following table: p/kPa 0.160 1.87 6.11 11.67 17.02 21.92 27.29 103 z 2.11 24.6 80.4 154 224 288 359 104 z/(1 − z)(V/mm3 ) 0.035 0.350 1.06 1.95 2.76 3.53 4.47 These points are plotted in Fig. 25.20. The least squares best line has an intercept at 0.0398, so = 3.98 × 10−6 mm−3 The slope of the line is 1.23 × 10−2 , so = (1.23 × 10−2 ) × 103 × 10−4 mm−3 = 1.23 × 10−3 mm−3 The solutions of these equations are c = 310 and Vmon = 811 mm3 . At 1.00 atm and 273 K, 811 mm3 corresponds to 3.6 × 10−5 mol, or 2.2 × 1019 atoms. Because each atom occupies an area of about 0.16 nm2 , the surface area of the sample is about 3.5 m2 . Self-test 25.3 Repeat the calculation for the following data: p/kPa 0.160 1.87 6.11 11.67 17.02 21.92 27.29 V/cm3 235 559 649 719 790 860 950 [370, 615 cm3 ] When c >> 1, the BET isotherm takes the simpler form = (25.10) This expression is applicable to unreactive gases on polar surfaces, for which c ≈ 102 because ∆desH7 is then significantly greater than ∆vapH7 (eqn 25.9). The BET isotherm 1 1 − z V Vmon c − 1 cVmon 1 cVmon (c − 1)z cVmon 1 cVmon z (1 − z)V 922 25 PROCESSES AT SOLID SURFACES fits experimental observations moderately well over restricted pressure ranges, but it errs by underestimating the extent of adsorption at low pressures and by overestimating it at high pressures. (c) Other isotherms An assumption of the Langmuir isotherm is the independence and equivalence of the adsorption sites. Deviations from the isotherm can often be traced to the failure of these assumptions. For example, the enthalpy of adsorption often becomes less negative as θ increases, which suggests that the energetically most favourable sites are occupied first. Various attempts have been made to take these variations into account. The Temkin isotherm, θ = c1 ln(c2p) (25.11) where c1 and c2 are constants, corresponds to supposing that the adsorption enthalpy changes linearly with pressure. The Freundlich isotherm θ = c1p1/c2 (25.12) corresponds to a logarithmic change. This isotherm attempts to incorporate the role of substrate–substrate interactions on the surface (see Problem 25.24). Different isotherms agree with experiment more or less well over restricted ranges of pressure, but they remain largely empirical. Empirical, however, does not mean useless for, if the parameters of a reasonably reliable isotherm are known, reasonably reliable results can be obtained for the extent of surface coverage under various conditions. This kind of information is essential for any discussion of heterogeneous catalysis. 25.5 The rates of surface processes The rates of surface processes may be studied by techniques described in Section 25.2 and Impact I25.1. Another technique, second harmonic generation (SHG), is very important for the study of all types of surfaces, including thin films and liquid–gas interfaces. We saw in Section 20.10 that second harmonic generation is the conversion of an intense, pulsed laser beam to radiation with twice its initial frequency as it passes though a material. In addition to a number of crystals, surfaces are also suitable materials for SHG. Because pulsed lasers are the excitation sources, time-resolved measurements of the kinetics and dynamics of surface processes are possible over timescales as short as femtoseconds. Figure 25.21 shows how the potential energy of a molecule varies with its distance from the substrate surface. As the molecule approaches the surface its energy falls as it becomes physisorbed into the precursor state for chemisorption. Dissociation into fragments often takes place as a molecule moves into its chemisorbed state, and after an initial increase of energy as the bonds stretch there is a sharp decrease as the adsorbate–substrate bonds reach their full strength. Even if the molecule does not fragment, there is likely to be an initial increase of potential energy as the molecule approaches the surface and the bonds adjust. In most cases, therefore, we can expect there to be a potential energy barrier separating the precursor and chemisorbed states. This barrier, though, might be low, and might not rise above the energy of a distant, stationary particle (as in Fig. 25.21a). In this case, chemisorption is not an activated process and can be expected to be rapid. Many gas adsorptions on clean metals appear to be non-activated. In some cases the barrier rises above the zero axis (as in Fig. 25.21b); such chemisorptions are activated and slower than the non-activated kind. An example is H2 on copper, which has an activation energy in the region of 20–40 kJ mol−1 . Fig. 25.21 The potential energy profiles for the dissociative chemisorption of an A2 molecule. In each case, P is the enthalpy of (non-dissociative) physisorption and C that for chemisorption (at T = 0). The relative locations of the curves determines whether the chemisorption is (a) not activated or (b) activated. 25.5 THE RATES OF SURFACE PROCESSES 923 One point that emerges from this discussion is that rates are not good criteria for distinguishing between physisorption and chemisorption. Chemisorption can be fast if the activation energy is small or zero, but it may be slow if the activation energy is large. Physisorption is usually fast, but it can appear to be slow if adsorption is taking place on a porous medium. (a) The rate of adsorption The rate at which a surface is covered by adsorbate depends on the ability of the substrate to dissipate the energy of the incoming particle as thermal motion as it crashes on to the surface. If the energy is not dissipated quickly, the particle migrates over the surface until a vibration expels it into the overlying gas or it reaches an edge. The proportion of collisions with the surface that successfully lead to adsorption is called the sticking probability, s: s = [25.13] The denominator can be calculated from the kinetic model, and the numerator can be measured by observing the rate of change of pressure. Values of s vary widely. For example, at room temperature CO has s in the range 0.1–1.0 for several d-metal surfaces, but for N2 on rhenium s < 10−2 , indicating that more than a hundred collisions are needed before one molecule sticks successfully. Beam studies on specific crystal planes show a pronounced specificity: for N2 on tungsten, s ranges from 0.74 on the (320) faces down to less than 0.01 on the (110) faces at room temperature. The sticking probability decreases as the surface coverage increases (Fig. 25.22). A simple assumption is that s is proportional to 1 − θ, the fraction uncovered, and it is common to write s = (1 − θ)s0 (25.14) where s0 is the sticking probability on a perfectly clean surface. The results in the illustration do not fit this expression because they show that s remains close to s0 until the coverage has risen to about 6 × 1013 molecules cm−2 , and then falls steeply. The explanation is probably that the colliding molecule does not enter the chemisorbed state at once, but moves over the surface until it encounters an empty site. (b) The rate of desorption Desorption is always activated because the particles have to be lifted from the foot of a potential well. A physisorbed particle vibrates in its shallow potential well, and might shake itself off the surface after a short time. The temperature dependence of the first-order rate of departure can be expected to be Arrhenius-like, with an activation energy for desorption, Ed, comparable to the enthalpy of physisorption: kd = Ae−Ed/RT (25.15) Therefore, the half-life for remaining on the surface has a temperature dependence t1/2 = = τ0eEd/RT τ0 = (25.16) (Note the positive sign in the exponent.) If we suppose that 1/τ0 is approximately the same as the vibrational frequency of the weak particle–surface bond (about 1012 Hz) and Ed ≈ 25 kJ mol−1 , then residence half-lives of around 10 ns are predicted at room temperature. Lifetimes close to 1 s are obtained only by lowering the temperature to about 100 K. For chemisorption, with Ed = 100 kJ mol−1 and guessing that τ0 = 10−14 s ln 2 A ln 2 kd rate of adsorption of particles by the surface rate of collision of particles with the surface Fig. 25.22 The sticking probability of N2 on various faces of a tungsten crystal and its dependence on surface coverage. Note the very low sticking probability for the (110) and (111) faces. (Data provided by Professor D.A. King.) 924 25 PROCESSES AT SOLID SURFACES (because the adsorbate–substrate bond is quite stiff), we expect a residence half-life of about 3 × 103 s (about an hour) at room temperature, decreasing to 1 s at about 350 K. The desorption activation energy can be measured in several ways. However, we must be guarded in its interpretation because it often depends on the fractional coverage, and so may change as desorption proceeds. Moreover, the transfer of concepts such as ‘reaction order’ and ‘rate constant’ from bulk studies to surfaces is hazardous, and there are few examples of strictly first-order or second-order desorption kinetics (just as there are few integral-order reactions in the gas phase too). If we disregard these complications, one way of measuring the desorption activation energy is to monitor the rate of increase in pressure when the sample is maintained at a series of temperatures, and to attempt to make an Arrhenius plot. A more sophisticated technique is temperature programmed desorption (TPD) or thermal desorption spectroscopy (TDS). The basic observation is a surge in desorption rate (as monitored by a mass spectrometer) when the temperature is raised linearly to the temperature at which desorption occurs rapidly, but once the desorption has occurred there is no more adsorbate to escape from the surface, so the desorption flux falls again as the temperature continues to rise. The TPD spectrum, the plot of desorption flux against temperature, therefore shows a peak, the location of which depends on the desorption activation energy. There are three maxima in the example shown in Fig. 25.23, indicating the presence of three sites with different activation energies. In many cases only a single activation energy (and a single peak in the TPD spectrum) is observed. When several peaks are observed they might correspond to adsorption on different crystal planes or to multilayer adsorption. For instance, Cd atoms on tungsten show two activation energies, one of 18 kJ mol−1 and the other of 90 kJ mol−1 . The explanation is that the more tightly bound Cd atoms are attached directly to the substrate, and the less strongly bound are in a layer (or layers) above the primary overlayer. Another example of a system showing two desorption activation energies is CO on tungsten, the values being 120 kJ mol−1 and 300 kJ mol−1 . The explanation is believed to be the existence of two types of metal–adsorbate binding site, one involving a simple M-CO bond, the other adsorption with dissociation into individually adsorbed C and O atoms. (b) Mobility on surfaces A further aspect of the strength of the interactions between adsorbate and substrate is the mobility of the adsorbate. Mobility is often a vital feature of a catalyst’s activity, because a catalyst might be impotent if the reactant molecules adsorb so strongly that they cannot migrate. The activation energy for diffusion over a surface need not be the same as for desorption because the particles may be able to move through valleys between potential peaks without leaving the surface completely. In general, the activation energy for migration is about 10–20 per cent of the energy of the surface– adsorbate bond, but the actual value depends on the extent of coverage. The defect structure of the sample (which depends on the temperature) may also play a dominant role because the adsorbed molecules might find it easier to skip across a terrace than to roll along the foot of a step, and these molecules might become trapped in vacancies in an otherwise flat terrace. Diffusion may also be easier across one crystal face than another, and so the surface mobility depends on which lattice planes are exposed. Diffusion characteristics of an adsorbate can be examined by using STM to follow the change in surface characteristics or by field-ionization microscopy (FIM), which portrays the electrical characteristics of a surface by using the ionization of noble gas atoms to probe the surface (Fig. 25.24). An individual atom is imaged, the temperature is raised, and then lowered after a definite interval. A new image is then recorded, and the new position of the atom measured (Fig. 25.25). A sequence of images shows Fig. 25.23 The flash desorption spectrum of H2 on the (100) face of tungsten. The three peaks indicate the presence of three sites with different adsorption enthalpies and therefore different desorption activation energies. (P.W. Tamm and L.D. Schmidt, J. Chem. Phys. 51, 5352 (1969).) Fig. 25.24 The events leading to an FIM image of a surface. The He atom migrates across the surface until it is ionized at an exposed atom, when it is pulled off by the externally applied potential. (The bouncing motion is due to the intermolecular potential, not gravity!) I25.1 IMPACT ON BIOCHEMISTRY: BIOSENSOR ANALYSIS 925 that the atom makes a random walk across the surface, and the diffusion coefficient, D, can be inferred from the mean distance, d, travelled in an interval τ by using the two-dimensional random walk expression d = (Dτ)1/2 . The value of D for different crystal planes at different temperatures can be determined directly in this way, and the activation energy for migration over each plane obtained from the Arrhenius-like expression D = D0e−ED/RT (25.17) where ED is the activation energy for diffusion. Typical values for W atoms on tungsten have ED in the range 57–87 kJ mol−1 and D0 ≈ 3.8 × 10−11 m2 s−1 . For CO on tungsten, the activation energy falls from 144 kJ mol−1 at low surface coverage to 88 kJ mol−1 when the coverage is high. IMPACT ON BIOCHEMISTRY I25.1 Biosensor analysis Biosensor analysis is a very sensitive and sophisticated optical technique that is now used routinely to measure the kinetics and thermodynamics of interactions between biopolymers. A biosensor detects changes in the optical properties of a surface in contact with a biopolymer. The mobility of delocalized valence electrons accounts for the electrical conductivity of metals and these mobile electrons form a plasma, a dense gas of charged particles. Bombardment of the plasma by light or an electron beam can cause transient changes in the distribution of electrons, with some regions becoming slightly more dense than others. Coulomb repulsion in the regions of high density causes electrons to move away from each other, so lowering their density. The resulting oscillations in electron density, called plasmons,can be excited both in the bulk and on the surface of a metal. Plasmons in the bulk may be visualized as waves that propagate through the solid. A surface plasmon also propagates away from the surface, but the amplitude of the wave, also called an evanescentwave,decreases sharply with distance from the surface. Biosensor analysis is based on the phenomenon of surface plasmon resonance (SPR), the absorption of energy from an incident beam of electromagnetic radiation by surface plasmons. Absorption, or ‘resonance’, can be observed with appropriate choice of the wavelength and angle of incidence of the excitation beam. It is common practice to use a monochromatic beam and to vary the angle of incidence θ (Fig. 25.26). The beam passes through a prism that strikes one side of a thin film of gold or silver. The angle corresponding to light absorption depends on the refractive index of the medium in direct contact with the opposing side of the metallic film. This variation of the resonance angle with the state of the surface arises from the ability of the evanescent wave to interact with material a short distance away from the surface. As an illustration of biosensor analysis, we consider the association of two polymers, A and B. In a typical experiment, a stream of solution containing a known concentration of A flows above the surface to which B is chemisorbed. Figure 25.27 shows that the kinetics of binding of A to B may be followed by monitoring the time dependence Fig. 25.25 FIM micrographs showing the migration of Re atoms on rhenium during 3 s intervals at 375 K. (Photographs provided by Professor G. Ehrlich.) Fig. 25.26 The experimental arrangement for the observation of surface plasmon resonance, as explained in the text. Fig. 25.27 The time dependence of a surface plasmon resonance signal, R, showing the effect of binding of a ligand to a biopolymer adsorbed on to a surface. Binding leads to an increase in R until an equilibrium value, Req, is obtained. Passing a solution containing no ligand over the surface leads to dissociation and decrease in R. 926 25 PROCESSES AT SOLID SURFACES of the SPR signal, denoted by R, which is typically the shift in resonance angle. The system is normally allowed to reach equilibrium, which is denoted by the plateau in Fig. 25.27. Then, a solution containing no A is flowed above the surface and the AB complex dissociates. Again, analysis of the decay of the SPR signal reveals the kinetics of dissociation of the AB complex. The equilibrium constant for formation of the AB complex can be measured directly from data of the type displayed in Fig. 25.27. Consider the equilibrium A + B 5 AB K = where kon and koff are the rate constants for formation and dissociation of the AB complex, and K is the equilibrium constant for formation of the AB complex. It follows that = kon[A][B] − koff[AB] (25.18) In a typical experiment, the flow rate of A is sufficiently high that [A] = a0 is essentially constant. We can also write [B] = b0 − [AB] from mass-balance considerations, where b0 is the total concentration of B. Finally, the SPR signal is often observed to be proportional to [AB]. The maximum value that R can have is Rmax ∝ b0, which would be measured if all B molecules were ligated to A. We may then write = kona0(Rmax − R) − koffR = kona0Rmax − (kona0 + koff)R (25.19) At equilibrium R = Req and dR/dt = 0. It follows that (after some algebra) Req = Rmax (25.20) Hence, the value of K can be obtained from measurements of Req for a series of a0. Biosensor analysis has been used in the study of thin films, metal–electrolyte surfaces, Langmuir–Blodgett films, and a number of biopolymer interactions, such as antibody–antigen and protein–DNA interactions. The most important advantage of the technique is its sensitivity; it is possible to measure the adsorption of nanograms of material on to a surface. For biological studies, the main disadvantage is the requirement for immobilization of at least one of the components of the system under study. Heterogeneous catalysis A catalyst acts by providing an alternative reaction path with a lower activation energy (Table 25.3). It does not disturb the final equilibrium composition of the system, only the rate at which that equilibrium is approached. In this section we consider heterogeneous catalysis, in which (as mentioned in the introduction to Section 23.5) the catalyst and the reagents are in different phases. For simplicity, we consider only gas/ solid systems. Many catalysts depend on co-adsorption, the adsorption of two or more species. One consequence of the presence of a second species may be the modification of the electronic structure at the surface of a metal. For instance, partial coverage of d-metal surfaces by alkali metals has a pronounced effect on the electron distribution and reduces the work function of the metal. Such modifiers can act as promoters (to enhance the action of catalysts) or as poisons (to inhibit catalytic action). D F a0K a0K + 1 A C dR dt d[AB] dt kon koff Synoptic table 25.3* Activation energies of catalysed reactions Reaction Catalyst Ea/(kJ mol−1 ) 2 HI → H2 + I2 None 184 Au 105 Pt 59 2 NH3 → None 350 N2 + 3 H2 W 162 * More values are given in the Data section. 25.6 MECHANISMS OF HETEROGENEOUS CATALYSIS 927 25.6 Mechanisms of heterogeneous catalysis Heterogeneous catalysis normally depends on at least one reactant being adsorbed (usually chemisorbed) and modified to a form in which it readily undergoes reaction. This modification often takes the form of a fragmentation of the reactant molecules. In practice, the active phase is dispersed as very small particles of linear dimension less than 2 nm on a porous oxide support. Shape-selective catalysts, such as the zeolites (Impact I25.2), which have a pore size that can distinguish shapes and sizes at a molecular scale, have high internal specific surface areas, in the range of 100–500 m2 g−1 . The decomposition of phosphine (PH3) on tungsten is first-order at low pressures and zeroth-order at high pressures. To account for these observations, we write down a plausible rate law in terms of an adsorption isotherm and explore its form in the limits of high and low pressure. If the rate is supposed to be proportional to the surface coverage and we suppose that θ is given by the Langmuir isotherm, we would write v = kθ = (25.21) where p is the pressure of phosphine. When the pressure is so low that Kp << 1, we can neglect Kp in the denominator and obtain v = kKp (25.22a) and the decomposition is first-order. When Kp >> 1, we can neglect the 1 in the denominator, whereupon the Kp terms cancel and we are left with v = k (25.22b) and the decomposition is zeroth-order. Self-test 25.4 Suggest the form of the rate law for the deuteration of NH3 in which D2 adsorbs dissociatively but not extensively (that is, Kp << 1, with p the partial pressure of D2), and NH3 (with partial pressure p′) adsorbs at different sites. [v = k(Kp)1/2 K′p′/(1 + K′p′)] In the Langmuir–Hinshelwood mechanism (LH mechanism) of surface-catalysed reactions, the reaction takes place by encounters between molecular fragments and atoms adsorbed on the surface. We therefore expect the rate law to be second-order in the extent of surface coverage: A + B → P v = kθAθB (25.23) Insertion of the appropriate isotherms for A and B then gives the reaction rate in terms of the partial pressures of the reactants. For example, if A and B follow Langmuir isotherms, and adsorb without dissociation, so that θA = θB = (25.24) then it follows that the rate law is v = (25.25) The parameters K in the isotherms and the rate constant k are all temperaturedependent, so the overall temperature dependence of the rate may be strongly nonArrhenius (in the sense that the reaction rate is unlikely to be proportional to e−Ea/RT ). kKAKBpApB (1 + KApA + KBpB)2 KBpB 1 + KApA + KBpB KApA 1 + KApA + KBpB kKp 1 + Kp 928 25 PROCESSES AT SOLID SURFACES The Langmuir–Hinshelwood mechanism is dominant for the catalytic oxidation of CO to CO2. In the Eley–Rideal mechanism (ER mechanism) of a surface-catalysed reaction, a gas-phase molecule collides with another molecule already adsorbed on the surface. The rate of formation of product is expected to be proportional to the partial pressure, pB, of the non-adsorbed gas B and the extent of surface coverage, θA, of the adsorbed gas A. It follows that the rate law should be A + B → P v = kpBθA (25.26) The rate constant, k, might be much larger than for the uncatalysed gas-phase reaction because the reaction on the surface has a low activation energy and the adsorption itself is often not activated. If we know the adsorption isotherm for A, we can express the rate law in terms of its partial pressure, pA. For example, if the adsorption of A follows a Langmuir isotherm in the pressure range of interest, then the rate law would be v = (25.27) If A were a diatomic molecule that adsorbed as atoms, we would substitute the isotherm given in eqn 25.6 instead. According to eqn 25.27, when the partial pressure of A is high (in the sense KpA >> 1) there is almost complete surface coverage, and the rate is equal to kpB. Now the ratedetermining step is the collision of B with the adsorbed fragments. When the pressure of A is low (KpA << 1), perhaps because of its reaction, the rate is equal to kKpApB; now the extent of surface coverage is important in the determination of the rate. Almost all thermal surface-catalysed reactions are thought to take place by the LH mechanism, but a number of reactions with an ER mechanism have also been identified from molecular beam investigations. For example, the reaction between H(g) and D(ad) to form HD(g) is thought to be by an ER mechanism involving the direct collision and pick-up of the adsorbed D atom by the incident H atom. However, the two mechanisms should really be thought of as ideal limits, and all reactions lie somewhere between the two and show features of each one. 25.7 Catalytic activity at surfaces Molecular beam reactive scattering (MBRS) studies are able to provide detailed information about catalysed reactions. It has become possible to investigate how the catalytic activity of a surface depends on its structure as well as its composition. For instance, the cleavage of C-H and H-H bonds appears to depend on the presence of steps and kinks, and a terrace often has only minimal catalytic activity. The reaction H2 + D2 → 2 HD has been studied in detail. For this reaction, terrace sites are inactive but one molecule in ten reacts when it strikes a step. Although the step itself might be the important feature, it may be that the presence of the step merely exposes a more reactive crystal face (the step face itself). Likewise, the dehydrogenation of hexane to hexene depends strongly on the kink density, and it appears that kinks are needed to cleave C-C bonds. These observations suggest a reason why even small amounts of impurities may poison a catalyst: they are likely to attach to step and kink sites, and so impair the activity of the catalyst entirely. A constructive outcome is that the extent of dehydrogenation may be controlled relative to other types of reactions by seeking impurities that adsorb at kinks and act as specific poisons. Molecular beam studies can also be used to investigate the details of the reaction process, particularly by using pulsed beams, in which the beam is chopped into short kKpApB 1 + KpA I25.2 IMPACT ON TECHNOLOGY: CATALYSIS IN THE CHEMICAL INDUSTRY 929 slugs. The angular distribution of the products, for instance, can be used to assess the length of time that a species remains on the surface during the reaction, for a long residence time will result in a loss of memory of the incident beam direction. The activity of a catalyst depends on the strength of chemisorption as indicated by the ‘volcano’ curve in Fig. 25.28 (which is so-called on account of its general shape). To be active, the catalyst should be extensively covered by adsorbate, which is the case if chemisorption is strong. On the other hand, if the strength of the substrate–adsorbate bond becomes too great, the activity declines either because the other reactant molecules cannot react with the adsorbate or because the adsorbate molecules are immobilized on the surface. This pattern of behaviour suggests that the activity of a catalyst should initially increase with strength of adsorption (as measured, for instance, by the enthalpy of adsorption) and then decline, and that the most active catalysts should be those lying near the summit of the volcano. Most active metals are those that lie close to the middle of the d block. Many metals are suitable for adsorbing gases, and the general order of adsorption strengths decreases along the series O2, C2H2, C2H4, CO, H2, CO2, N2. Some of these molecules adsorb dissociatively (for example, H2). Elements from the d block, such as iron, vanadium, and chromium, show a strong activity towards all these gases, but manganese and copper are unable to adsorb N2 and CO2. Metals towards the left of the periodic table (for example, magnesium and lithium) can adsorb (and, in fact, react with) only the most active gas (O2). These trends are summarized in Table 25.4. IMPACT ON TECHNOLOGY I25.2 Catalysis in the chemical industry Almost the whole of modern chemical industry depends on the development, selection, and application of catalysts (Table 25.5). All we can hope to do in this section is to give a brief indication of some of the problems involved. Other than the ones we consider, these problems include the danger of the catalyst being poisoned by byproducts or impurities, and economic considerations relating to cost and lifetime. An example of catalytic action is found in the hydrogenation of alkenes. The alkene (2) adsorbs by forming two bonds with the surface (3), and on the same surface there may be adsorbed H atoms. When an encounter occurs, one of the alkene–surface bonds is broken (forming 4 or 5) and later an encounter with a second H atom releases the fully hydrogenated hydrocarbon, which is the thermodynamically more stable species. The evidence for a two-stage reaction is the appearance of different isomeric alkenes in the mixture. The formation of isomers comes about because, while the hydrocarbon chain is waving about over the surface of the metal, an atom in the chain Fig. 25.28 A volcano curve of catalytic activity arises because, although the reactants must adsorb reasonably strongly, they must not adsorb so strongly that they are immobilized. The lower curve refers to the first series of d-block metals, the upper curve to the second and third series d-block metals. The group numbers relate to the periodic table inside the back cover. Table 25.4 Chemisorption abilities* O2 C2H2 C2H4 CO H2 CO2 N2 Ti, Cr, Mo, Fe + + + + + + + Ni, Co + + + + + + − Pd, Pt + + + + + − − Mn, Cu + + + + ± − − Al, Au + + + + − − − Li, Na, K + + − − − − − Mg, Ag, Zn, Pb + − − − − − − * +, Strong chemisorption; ±, chemisorption; −, no chemisorption. 930 25 PROCESSES AT SOLID SURFACES might chemisorb again to form (6) and then desorb to (7), an isomer of the original molecule. The new alkene would not be formed if the two hydrogen atoms attached simultaneously. A major industrial application of catalytic hydrogenation is to the formation of edible fats from vegetable and animal oils. Raw oils obtained from sources such as the soya bean have the structure CH2(OOCR)CH(OOCR′)CH2(OOCR″), where R, R′, and R″ are long-chain hydrocarbons with several double bonds. One disadvantage of the presence of many double bonds is that the oils are susceptible to atmospheric oxidation, and therefore are liable to become rancid. The geometrical configuration of the chains is responsible for the liquid nature of the oil, and in many applications a solid fat is at least much better and often necessary. Controlled partial hydrogenation of an oil with a catalyst carefully selected so that hydrogenation is incomplete and so that the chains do not isomerize (finely divided nickel, in fact), is used on a wide scale to produce edible fats. The process, and the industry, is not made any easier by the seasonal variation of the number of double bonds in the oils. Catalytic oxidation is also widely used in industry and in pollution control. Although in some cases it is desirable to achieve complete oxidation (as in the production of nitric acid from ammonia), in others partial oxidation is the aim. For example, the complete oxidation of propene to carbon dioxide and water is wasteful, but its partial oxidation to propenal (acrolein, CH2=CHCHO) is the start of important industrial processes. Likewise, the controlled oxidations of ethene to ethanol, ethanal (acetaldehyde), and (in the presence of acetic acid or chlorine) to chloroethene (vinyl chloride, forthemanufactureofPVC),aretheinitialstagesofveryimportantchemicalindustries. Some of these oxidation reactions are catalysed by d-metal oxides of various kinds. The physical chemistry of oxide surfaces is very complex, as can be appreciated by considering what happens during the oxidation of propene to propenal on bismuth molybdate. The first stage is the adsorption of the propene molecule with loss of a hydrogen to form the propenyl (allyl) radical, CH2=CHCH2. An O atom in the surface can now transfer to this radical, leading to the formation of propenal and its desorption from the surface. The H atom also escapes with a surface O atom, and goes on to form H2O, which leaves the surface. The surface is left with vacancies and metal ions in lower oxidation states. These vacancies are attacked by O2 molecules in the overlying gas,whichthenchemisorbasO2 − ions,soreformingthecatalyst.Thissequenceofevents, which is called the Mars van Krevelen mechanism, involves great upheavals of the surface, and some materials break up under the stress. Many of the small organic molecules used in the preparation of all kinds of chemical products come from oil. These small building blocks of polymers, perfumes, and petrochemicals in general, are usually cut from the long-chain hydrocarbons drawn from the Earth as petroleum. The catalytically induced fragmentation of the Table 25.5 Properties of catalysts Catalyst Function Examples Metals Hydrogenation Fe, Ni, Pt, Ag Dehydrogenation Semiconducting oxides and sulfides Oxidation NiO, ZnO, MgO, Bi2O3/MoO3, MoS2 Desulfurization Insulating oxides Dehydration Al2O3, SiO2, MgO Acids Polymerization H3PO4, H2SO4, SiO3/Al2O3, zeolites Isomerization Cracking Alkylation I25.2 IMPACT ON TECHNOLOGY: CATALYSIS IN THE CHEMICAL INDUSTRY 931 long-chain hydrocarbons is called cracking, and is often brought about on silica– alumina catalysts. These catalysts act by forming unstable carbocations, which dissociate and rearrange to more highly branched isomers. These branched isomers burn more smoothly and efficiently in internal combustion engines, and are used to produce higher octane fuels. Catalytic reforming uses a dual-function catalyst, such as a dispersion of platinum and acidic alumina. The platinum provides the metal function, and brings about dehydrogenation and hydrogenation. The alumina provides the acidic function, being able to form carbocations from alkenes. The sequence of events in catalytic reforming shows up very clearly the complications that must be unravelled if a reaction as important as this is to be understood and improved. The first step is the attachment of the long-chain hydrocarbon by chemisorption to the platinum. In this process first one and then a second H atom is lost, and an alkene is formed. The alkene migrates to a Brønsted acid site, where it accepts a proton and attaches to the surface as a carbocation. This carbocation can undergo several different reactions. It can break into two, isomerize into a more highly branched form, or undergo varieties of ring-closure. Then the adsorbed molecule loses a proton, escapes from the surface, and migrates (possibly through the gas) as an alkene to a metal part of the catalyst where it is hydrogenated. We end up with a rich selection of smaller molecules which can be withdrawn, fractionated, and then used as raw materials for other products. The concept of a solid surface has been extended with the availability of microporous materials, in which the surface effectively extends deep inside the solid. Zeolites are microporous aluminosilicates with the general formula {[Mn+ ]x/n· [H2O]m}{[AlO2]x[SiO2]y}x− , where Mn+ cations and H2O molecules bind inside the cavities, or pores, of the Al-O-Si framework (Fig. 25.29). Small neutral molecules, such as CO2, NH3, and hydrocarbons (including aromatic compounds), can also adsorb to the internal surfaces and we shall see that this partially accounts for the utility of zeolites as catalysts. Some zeolites for which M = H+ are very strong acids and catalyse a variety of reactions that are of particular importance to the petrochemical industry. Examples include the dehydration of methanol to form hydrocarbons such as gasoline and other fuels: x CH3OH zeolite −−−→ (CH2)x + xH2O and the isomerization of m-xylene (8) to p-xylene (9). The catalytically important form of these acidic zeolites may be either a Brønsted acid (10) or a Lewis acid (11). Like enzymes, a zeolite catalyst with a specific compostion and structure is very selective toward certain reactants and products because only molecules of certain sizes can enter Fig. 25.29 A framework representation of the general layout of the Si, Al, and O atoms in a zeolite material. Each vertex corresponds to a Si or Al atom and each edge corresponds to the approximate location of a O atom. Note the large central pore, which can hold cations, water molecules, or other small molecules. 932 25 PROCESSES AT SOLID SURFACES and exit the pores in which catalysis occurs. It is also possible that zeolites derive their selectivity from the ability to bind and to stabilize only transition states that fit properly in the pores. The analysis of the mechanism of zeolyte catalysis is greatly facilitated by computer simulation of microporous systems, which shows how molecules fit in the pores, migrate through the connecting tunnels, and react at the appropriate active sites. Processes at electrodes A special kind of surface is an electrode and the special kind of process that occurs there is the transfer of electrons. Detailed knowledge of the factors that determine the rate of electron transfer at electrodes leads to a better understanding of power production in batteries, and of electron conduction in metals, semiconductors, and nanometre-sized electronic devices. Indeed, the economic consequences of electron transfer reactions are almost incalculable. Most of the modern methods of generating electricity are inefficient, and the development of fuel cells could revolutionize our production and deployment of energy (Impact I25.3). Today we produce energy inefficiently to produce goods that then decay by corrosion. Each step of this wasteful sequence could be improved by discovering more about the kinetics of electrochemical processes. Similarly, the techniques of organic and inorganic electrosynthesis, where an electrode is an active component of an industrial process, depend on intimate understanding of the kinetics of electron transfer processes. As for homogeneous systems (Chapter 24), electron transfer at the surface of an electrode involves electron tunnelling. However, the electrode possesses a nearly infinite number of closely spaced electronic energy levels rather than the small number of discrete levels of a typical complex. Furthermore, specific interactions with the electrode surface give the solute and solvent special properties that can be very different from those observed in the bulk of the solution. For this reason, we begin with a description of the electrode–solution interface. Then, we describe the kinetics of electrode processes by using a largely phenomenological (rather than strictly theoretical) approachthatdrawsonthethermodynamiclanguageinspiredbytransitionstatetheory. 25.8 The electrode–solution interface The most primitive model of the boundary between the solid and liquid phases is as an electrical double layer, which consists of a sheet of positive charge at the surface of the electrode and a sheet of negative charge next to it in the solution (or vice versa). We shall see that this arrangement creates an electrical potential difference, called the Galvani potential difference, between the bulk of the metal electrode and the bulk of the solution. More sophisticated models for the electrode–solution interface attempt to describe the gradual changes in the structure of the solution between two extremes: the charged electrode surface and the bulk of the solution. (a) The structure of the interface A more detailed picture of the interface can be constructed by speculating about the arrangement of ions and electric dipoles in the solution. In the Helmholtz layer model of the interface the solvated ions arrange themselves along the surface of the electrode but are held away from it by their hydration spheres (Fig. 25.30). The location of the sheet of ionic charge, which is called the outer Helmholtz plane (OHP), is identified as the plane running through the solvated ions. In this simple model, the electrical potential changes linearly within the layer bounded by the electrode surface on one side and the OHP on the other (see Exercise 25.15a). In a refinement of this Fig. 25.30 A simple model of the electrode–solution interface treats it as two rigid planes of charge. One plane, the outer Helmholtz plane (OHP), is due to the ions with their solvating molecules and the other plane is that of the electrode itself. The plot shows the dependence of the electric potential with distance from the electrode surface according to this model. Between the electrode surface and the OHP, the potential varies linearly from ϕM, the value in the metal, to ϕS, the value in the bulk of the solution. 25.8 THE ELECTRODE–SOLUTION INTERFACE 933 model, ions that have discarded their solvating molecules and have become attached totheelectrodesurfacebychemicalbondsareregardedasformingtheinnerHelmholtz plane (IHP). The Helmholtz layer model ignores the disrupting effect of thermal motion, which tends to break up and disperse the rigid outer plane of charge. In the Gouy–Chapman model of the diffuse double layer, the disordering effect of thermal motion is taken into account in much the same way as the Debye–Hückel model describes the ionic atmosphere of an ion (Section 5.9) with the latter’s single central ion replaced by an infinite, plane electrode. Figure 25.31 shows how the local concentrations of cations and anions differ in the Gouy–Chapman model from their bulk concentrations. Ions of opposite charge cluster close to the electrode and ions of the same charge are repelled from it. The modification of the local concentrations near an electrode implies that it might be misleading to use activity coefficients characteristic of the bulk to discuss the thermodynamic properties of ions near the interface. This is one of the reasons why measurements of the dynamics of electrode processes are almost always done using a large excess of supporting electrolyte (for example, a 1 m solution of a salt, an acid, or a base). Under such conditions, the activity coefficients are almost constant because the inert ions dominate the effects of local changes caused by any reactions taking place. The use of a concentrated solution also minimizes ion migration effects. Neither the Helmholtz nor the Gouy–Chapman model is a very good representation of the structure of the double layer. The former overemphasizes the rigidity of the local solution; the latter underemphasizes its structure. The two are combined in the Stern model, in which the ions closest to the electrode are constrained into a rigid Helmholtz plane while outside that plane the ions are dispersed as in the Gouy– Chapman model (Fig. 25.32). Yet another level of sophistication is found in the Grahame model, which adds an inner Helmholtz plane to the Stern model. Fig. 25.31 The Gouy–Chapman model of the electrical double layer treats the outer region as an atmosphere of counter-charge, similar to the Debye–Hückel theory of ion atmospheres. The plot of electrical potential against distance from the electrode surface shows the meaning of the diffuse double layer (see text for details). Fig. 25.32 A representation of the Stern model of the electrode–solution interface. The model incorporates the idea of an outer Helmholtz plane near the electrode surface and of a diffuse double layer further away from the surface. 934 25 PROCESSES AT SOLID SURFACES (b) The electric potential at the interface The potential at the interface can be analysed by imagining the separation of the electrode from the solution, but with the charges of the metal and the solution frozen in position. A positive test charge at great distances from the isolated electrode experiences a Coulomb potential that varies inversely with distance (Fig. 25.33). As the test charge approaches the electrode, which can be a metal or membrane electrode, it enters a region where the potential varies more slowly. This change in behaviour can be traced to the fact that the surface charge is not point-like but is spread over an area. At about 100 nm from the surface the potential varies only slightly with distance because the closer the point of observation is to the surface, although the potential from a given region of charge is stronger, a smaller area of surface is sampled (Fig. 25.34). The potential in this region is called the outer potential, ψ. As the test charge is taken through the skin of electrons on the surface of the electrode, the potential it experiences changes until the probe reaches the inner, bulk metal environment, where the potential is called the inner potential, φ. The difference between the inner and outer potentials is called the surface potential, χ. A similar sequence of changes of potential is observed as a positive test charge is brought up to and through the solution surface. The potential changes to its outer value as the charge approaches the charged medium, then to its inner value as the probe is taken into the bulk. Now consider bringing the electrode and solution back together again but without any change of charge distribution. The potential difference between points in the bulk metal and the bulk solution is the Galvani potential difference, ∆φ. Apart from a constant, this Galvani potential difference is the electrode potential that was discussed in Chapter 7. We shall ignore the constant, which cannot be measured anyway, and identify changes in ∆φ with changes in electrode potential (see Further information 25.1 for a quantitative treatment). 25.9 The rate of charge transfer Because an electrode reaction is heterogeneous, it is natural to express its rate as the flux of products, the amount of material produced over a region of the electrode surface in an interval of time divided by the area of the region and the duration of the interval. (a) The rate laws A first-order heterogeneous rate law has the form Product flux = k[species] (25.28) where [species] is the molar concentration of the relevant species in solution close to the electrode, just outside the double layer. The rate constant has dimensions of length/time (with units, for example, of centimetres per second, cm s−1 ). If the molar concentrations of the oxidized and reduced materials outside the double layer are [Ox] and [Red], respectively, then the rate of reduction of Ox, vOx, is vOx = kc[Ox] (25.29a) and the rate of oxidation of Red, vRed, is vRed = ka[Red] (25.29b) (The notation kc and ka is justified below.) Now consider a reaction at the electrode in which an ion is reduced by the transfer of a single electron in the rate-determining step. For instance, in the deposition of Fig. 25.33 The variation of potential with distance from an electrode that has been separated from the electrolyte solution without there being an adjustment of charge. A similar diagram applies to the separated solution. Fig. 25.34 The origin of the distanceindependence of the outer potential. (a) Far from the electrode, a point charge experiences a potential arising from a wide area but each contribution is weak. (b) Close to the electrode, the point charge experiences a potential arising from a small area but each contribution is strong. Provided the point charge is in a certain range of values (and, specifically, where image charge effects can be ignored) the potential it experiences is largely independent of distance. 25.9 THE RATE OF CHARGE TRANSFER 935 cadmium only one electron is transferred in the rate-determining step even though overall the deposition involves the transfer of two electrons. The net current density at the electrode is the difference between the current densities arising from the reduction of Ox and the oxidation of Red. Because the redox processes at the electrode involve the transfer of one electron per reaction event, the current densities, j, arising from the redox processes are the rates (as expressed above) multiplied by the charge transferred per mole of reaction, which is given by Faraday’s constant. Therefore, there is a cathodic current density of magnitude jc = Fkc[Ox] for Ox + e− → Red (25.30a) arising from the reduction (because, as we saw in Chapter 7, the cathode is the site of reduction). There is also an opposing anodic current density of magnitude ja = Fka[Red] for Red → Ox + e− (25.30b) arising from the oxidation (because the anode is the site of oxidation). The net current density at the electrode is the difference j = ja − jc = Fka[Red] − Fkc[Ox] (25.30c) Note that, when ja > jc, so that j > 0, the current is anodic (Fig. 25.35a); when jc > ja, so that j < 0, the current is cathodic (Fig. 25.35b). (b) The activation Gibbs energy If a species is to participate in reduction or oxidation at an electrode, it must discard any solvating molecules, migrate through the electrode–solution interface, and adjust its hydration sphere as it receives or discards electrons. Likewise, a species already at the inner plane must be detached and migrate into the bulk. Because both processes are activated, we can expect to write their rate constants in the form suggested by transition state theory (Section 24.4) as k = Be−∆‡ G/RT (25.31) where ∆‡ G is the activation Gibbs energy and B is a constant with the same dimensions as k. When eqn 25.31 is inserted into eqn 25.30 we obtain j = FBa[Red]e−∆‡ Ga/RT − FBc[Ox]e−∆‡ Gc/RT (25.32) This expression allows the activation Gibbs energies to be different for the cathodic and anodic processes. That they are different is the central feature of the remaining discussion. (c) The Butler–Volmer equation Now we relate j to the Galvani potential difference, which varies across the electrode– solution interface as shown schematically in Fig. 25.36. Consider the reduction reaction, Ox + e− → Red, and the corresponding reaction profile. If the transition state of the activated complex is product-like (as represented by the peak of the reaction profile being close to the electrode in Fig. 25.37), the activation Gibbs energy is changed from ∆‡ Gc(0), the value it has in the absence of a potential difference across the double layer, to ∆‡ Gc = ∆‡ Gc(0) + F∆φ (25.33a) Thus, if the electrode is more positive than the solution, ∆φ > 0, then more work has to be done to form an activated complex from Ox; in this case the activation Gibbs energy is increased. If the transition state is reactant-like (represented by the peak of Fig. 25.35 The net current density is defined as the difference between the cathodic and anodic contributions. (a) When ja > jc, the net current is anodic, and there is a net oxidation of the species in solution. (b) When jc > ja, the net current is cathodic, and the net process is reduction. Fig. 25.36 The potential, φ, varies linearly between two plane parallel sheets of charge, and its effect on the Gibbs energy of the transition state depends on the extent to which the latter resembles the species at the inner or outer planes. 936 25 PROCESSES AT SOLID SURFACES the reaction profile being close to the outer plane of the double-layer in Fig. 25.38), then ∆‡ Gc is independent of ∆φ. In a real system, the transition state has an intermediate resemblance to these extremes (Fig. 25.39) and the activation Gibbs energy for reduction may be written as ∆‡ Gc = ∆‡ Gc(0) + αF∆φ (25.33b) The parameter α is called the (cathodic) transfer coefficient, and lies in the range 0 to 1. Experimentally, α is often found to be about 0.5. Now consider the oxidation reaction, Red + e− → Ox and its reaction profile. Similar remarks apply. In this case, Red discards an electron to the electrode, so the extra work is zero if the transition state is reactant-like (represented by a peak close to the electrode). The extra work is the full −F∆φ if it resembles the product (the peak close to the outer plane). In general, the activation Gibbs energy for this anodic process is ∆‡ Ga = ∆‡ Ga(0) − (1 − α)F∆φ (25.34) The two activation Gibbs energies can now be inserted in place of the values used in eqn 25.32 with the result that Fig. 25.37 When the transition state resembles a species that has undergone reduction, the activation Gibbs energy for the anodic current is almost unchanged, but the full effect applies to the cathodic current. (a) Zero potential difference; (b) nonzero potential difference. Fig. 25.38 When the transition state resembles a species that has undergone oxidation, the activation Gibbs energy for the cathodic current is almost unchanged but the activation Gibbs energy for the anodic current is strongly affected. (a) Zero potential difference; (b) nonzero potential difference. Fig. 25.39 When the transition state is intermediate in its resemblance to reduced and oxidized species, as represented here by a peak located at an intermediate position as measured by α (with 0 < α < 1), both activation Gibbs energies are affected; here, α ≈ 0.5. (a) Zero potential difference; (b) nonzero potential difference. 25.9 THE RATE OF CHARGE TRANSFER 937 Comment 25.1 Here we are assuming that we can identify the Galvani potential difference and the zero-current electrode potential. As explained earlier, they differ by a constant amount, which may be regarded as absorbed into the constant B. j = FBa[Red]e−∆‡ Ga(0)/RT e(1−α)F∆φ/RT − FBc[Ox]e−∆‡ Gc(0)/RT e−αF∆φ/RT (25.35) This is an explicit, if complicated, expression for the net current density in terms of the potential difference. The appearance of eqn 25.35 can be simplified. First, in a purely cosmetic step we write f = [25.36] Next, we identify the individual cathodic and anodic current densities: ja = FBa[Red]e−∆‡ Ga(0)/RT e(1−α)f∆φ jc = FBc[Ox]e−∆‡ Gc(0)/RT e−αf∆φ j = ja − jc (25.37) Illustration 25.1 Calculating the current density 1 To calculate the change in cathodic current density at an electrode when the potential difference changes from ∆φ′ and ∆φ, we use eqn 25.37 to express the ratio of cathodic current densities jc′ and jc = e−αf(∆φ′−∆φ) When ∆φ′ − ∆φ = 1.0 V, T = 298 K, and α = 1 –2 (a typical value), we obtain αf × (∆φ′ − ∆φ) = = Hence (after using 1 J = 1 VC), = e − = 4 × 10−9 This huge change in current density, by a factor of a billion, occurs for a very mild and easily applied change of conditions. We can appreciate why the change is so great by realizing that a change of potential difference by 1 V changes the activation Gibbs energy by (1 V) × F, or about 50 kJ mol−1 , which has an enormous effect on the rates. Self-test 25.5 Calculate the change in anodic current density under the same circumstances. [j′a/ja = 3 × 108 ] If the cell is balanced against an external source, the Galvani potential difference, ∆φ, can be identified as the (zero-current) electrode potential, E, and we can write ja = FBa[Red]e−∆‡ Ga(0)/RT e(1−α)fE jc = FBc[Ox]e−∆‡ Gc(0)/RT e−αfE (25.38) When these equations apply, there is no net current at the electrode (as the cell is balanced), so the two current densities must be equal. From now on we denote them both as j0, which is called the exchange current density. When the cell is producing current (that is, when a load is connected between the electrode being studied and a second counter electrode) the electrode potential changes 9.6485×104 ×1.0 2×8.3145×298 j′c jc 9.6485 × 104 × 1.0 2 × 8.3145 × 298 1 –2 × (9.6485 × 104 C mol−1 ) × (1.0 V) (8.3145 J K−1 mol−1 ) × (298 K) j′c jc 5 6 7 F RT 938 25 PROCESSES AT SOLID SURFACES from its zero-current value, E, to a new value, E′, and the difference is the electrode’s overpotential, η: η = E′ − E [25.39] Hence, ∆φ changes to ∆φ = E + η and the two current densities become ja = j0e(1−α)fη jc = j0e−αfη (25.40) Then from eqn 25.32 we obtain the Butler–Volmer equation: j = j0{e(1−α)fη − e−αfη } (25.41) This equation is the basis of all that follows. (d) The low overpotential limit When the overpotential is so small that fη << 1 (in practice, η less than about 0.01 V) the exponentials in eqn 25.41 can be expanded by using ex = 1 + x + · · · to give j = j0{1 + (1 − α)fη + · · · − (1 − αfη + · · · )} ≈ j0 fη (25.42) This equation shows that the current density is proportional to the overpotential, so at low overpotentials the interface behaves like a conductor that obeys Ohm’s law. When there is a small positive overpotential the current is anodic (j > 0 when η > 0), and when the overpotential is small and negative the current is cathodic (j < 0 when η < 0). The relation can also be reversed to calculate the potential difference that must exist if a current density j has been established by some external circuit: η = (25.43) The importance of this interpretation will become clear below. Illustration 25.2 Calculating the current density 2 The exchange current density of a Pt(s)|H2(g)|H+ (aq) electrode at 298 K is 0.79 mA cm−2 . Therefore, the current density when the overpotential is +5.0 mV is obtained by using eqn 25.42 and f = F/RT = 1/(25.69 mV): j = j0fη = = 0.15 mA cm−2 The current through an electrode of total area 5.0 cm2 is therefore 0.75 mA. Self-test 25.6 What would be the current at pH = 2.0, the other conditions being the same? [−18 mA (cathodic)] (e) The high overpotential limit When the overpotential is large and positive (in practice, η ≥ 0.12 V), corresponding to the electrode being the anode in electrolysis, the second exponential in eqn 25.41 is much smaller than the first, and may be neglected. Then j = j0e(1−α)fη (25.44) so ln j = ln j0 + (1 − α)fη (25.45) (0.79 mA cm−2 ) × (5.0 mV) 25.69 mV RTj Fj0 25.9 THE RATE OF CHARGE TRANSFER 939 Fig. 25.40 The general arrangement for electrochemical rate measurements. The external source establishes a current between the working electrode and the counter electrode, and its effect on the potential difference of either of them relative to the reference electrode is observed. No current flows in the reference circuit. Fig. 25.41 A Tafel plot is used to measure the exchange current density (given by the extrapolated intercept at η = 0) and the transfer coefficient (from the slope). The data are from Example 25.4. When the overpotential is large but negative (in practice, η ≤ −0.12 V), corresponding to the cathode in electrolysis, the first exponential in eqn 25.41 may be neglected. Then j = −j0e−αfη (25.46) so ln(−j) = ln j0 − αfη (25.47) The plot of the logarithm of the current density against the overpotential is called a Tafel plot. The slope gives the value of α and the intercept at η = 0 gives the exchange current density. The experimental arrangement used for a Tafel plot is shown in Fig. 25.40. A similar arrangement is typical of all kinds of electrochemical rate measurements. The current-carrying electrodes are the working electrode, the electrode of interest, and the counter electrode, which is necessary to complete the electrical circuit. The current flowing through them is controlled externally. If the area of the working electrode is A and the current is I, the current density across its surface is I/A. The potential difference across the interface cannot be measured directly, but the potential of the working electrode relative to a third electrode, the reference electrode, can be measured with a high impedance voltmeter, and no current flows in that half of the circuit. The reference electrode is in contact with the solution close to the working electrode through a ‘Luggin capillary’, which helps to eliminate any ohmic potential difference that might arise accidentally. Changing the current flowing through the working circuit causes a change of potential of the working electrode, and that change is measured with the voltmeter. The overpotential is then obtained by taking the difference between the potentials measured with and without a flow of current through the working circuit. Example 25.4 Interpreting a Tafel plot The data below refer to the anodic current through a platinum electrode of area 2.0 cm2 in contact with an Fe3+ ,Fe2+ aqueous solution at 298 K. Calculate the exchange current density and the transfer coefficient for the electrode process. η/mV 50 100 150 200 250 I/mA 8.8 25.0 58.0 131 298 Method The anodic process is the oxidation Fe2+ (aq) → Fe3+ (aq) + e− . To analyse the data, we make a Tafel plot (of ln j against η) using the anodic form (eqn 25.45). The intercept at η = 0 is ln j0 and the slope is (1 − α)f. Answer Draw up the following table: η/mV 50 100 150 200 250 j/(mA cm−2 ) 4.4 12.5 29.0 65.5 149 ln(j/(mA cm−2 )) 1.48 2.53 3.37 4.18 5.00 The points are plotted in Fig. 25.41. The high overpotential region gives a straight line of intercept 0.88 and slope 0.0165. From the former it follows that ln(j0/ (mA cm−2 )) = 0.88, so j0 = 2.4 mA cm−2 . From the latter, (1 − α) = 0.0165 mV−1 F RT 940 25 PROCESSES AT SOLID SURFACES Synoptic table 25.6* Exchange current densities and transfer coefficients at 298 K Reaction Electrode j0/(A cm−2 ) a 2 H+ + 2 e− → H2 Pt 7.9 × 10−4 Ni 6.3 × 10−6 0.58 Pb 5.0 × 10−12 Fe3+ + e− → Fe2+ Pt 2.5 × 10−3 0.58 * More values are given in the Data section. so α = 0.58. Note that the Tafel plot is nonlinear for η < 100 mV; in this region αfη = 2.3 and the approximation that αfη >> 1 fails. Self-test 25.7 Repeat the analysis using the following cathodic current data: η/mV −50 −100 −150 −200 −250 −300 I/mA −0.3 −1.5 −6.4 −27.6 −118.6 −510 [α = 0.75, j0 = 0.041 mA cm−2 ] Some experimental values for the Butler–Volmer parameters are given in Table 25.6. From them we can see that exchange current densities vary over a very wide range. For example, the N2,N3 − couple on platinum has j0 = 10−76 A cm−2 , whereas the H+ ,H2 couple on platinum has j0 = 8 × 10−4 A cm−2 , a difference of 73 orders of magnitude. Exchange currents are generally large when the redox process involves no bond breaking (as in the [Fe(CN)6]3− ,[Fe(CN)6]4− couple) or if only weak bonds are broken (as in Cl2,Cl− ). They are generally small when more than one electron needs to be transferred, or when multiple or strong bonds are broken, as in the N2,N3 − couple and in redox reactions of organic compounds. 25.10 Voltammetry The kinetics of electrode processes can be studied by voltammetry, in which the current is monitored as the potential of the electrode is changed, and by chronopotentiometry, in which the potential is monitored as the current flow is changed. Voltammetry may also be used to identify species present in solution and to determine their concentration. Before we describe voltammetry in detail, we need to understand how electrode potentials vary with current. Electrodes with potentials that change only slightly when a current passes through them are classified as non-polarizable. Those with strongly current-dependent potentials are classified as polarizable. From the linearized equation (eqn 25.43) it is clear that the criterion for low polarizability is high exchange current density (so η may be small even though j is large). The calomel and H2/Pt electrodes are both highly non-polarizable, which is one reason why they are so extensively used as reference electrodes in electrochemistry. (a) Concentration polarization One of the assumptions in the derivation of the Butler–Volmer equation is the negligible conversion of the electroactive species at low current densities, resulting in uniformity of concentration near the electrode. This assumption fails at high current 25.10 VOLTAMMETRY 941 densities because the consumption of electroactive species close to the electrode results in a concentration gradient; diffusion of the species towards the electrode from the bulk is slow and may become rate-determining. A larger overpotential is then needed to produce a given current. This effect is called concentration polarization and its contribution to the total overpotential is called the polarization overpotential, ηc . Consider a case for which the concentration polarization dominates all the rate processes and a redox couple of the type Mz+ ,M with the reduction Mz+ + z e− → M. Under zero-current conditions, when the net current density is zero, the electrode potential is related to the activity, a, of the ions in the solution by the Nernst equation (eqn 7.29): E = E7 + ln a (25.48) As remarked earlier, electrode kinetics are normally studied using a large excess of support electrolyte so as to keep the mean activity coefficients approximately constant. Therefore, the constant activity coefficient in a = γc may be absorbed into E, and we write the formal potential, E°, of the electrode as E° = E7 + ln γ [25.49] Then the electrode potential is E = E° + ln c (25.50) When the cell is producing current, the active ion concentration at the OHP changes to c′ and the electrode potential changes to E′ = E° + ln c′ (25.51) The concentration overpotential is therefore ηc = E′ + E = ln (25.52) We now suppose that the solution has its bulk concentration, c, up to a distance δ from the outer Helmholtz plane, and then falls linearly to c′ at the plane itself. This Nernst diffusion layer is illustrated in Fig. 25.42. The thickness of the Nernst layer (which is typically 0.1 mm, and strongly dependent on the condition of hydrodynamic flow due to any stirring or convective effects) is quite different from that of the electric double layer (which is typically less than 1 nm, and unaffected by stirring). The concentration gradient through the Nernst layer is = (25.53) This gradient gives rise to a flux of ions towards the electrode, which replenishes the cations as they are reduced. The (molar) flux, J, is proportional to the concentration gradient, and according to Fick’s first law (Section 21.4) J = −D (25.54) Therefore, the particle flux towards the electrode is J = D (25.55) c − c′ δ D F ∂c ∂x A C c′ − c δ dc dx D F c′ c A C RT zF RT zF RT zF RT zF RT zF Fig. 25.42 In a simple model of the Nernst diffusion layer there is a linear variation in concentration between the bulk and the outer Helmholtz plane; the thickness of the layer depends strongly on the state of flow of the fluid. Note that the diffusion layer is much thicker relative to the OHP than shown here. 942 25 PROCESSES AT SOLID SURFACES The cathodic current density towards the electrode is the product of the particle flux and the charge transferred per mole of ions, zF: j = zFJ = zFD (25.56) For instance, for the couple [Fe(CN)6]2− /[Fe(CN)6]3− , z = 1, but for Fe3+ /Fe, z = 3. The maximum rate of diffusion across the Nernst layer occurs when the gradient is steepest, which is when c′ = 0. This concentration occurs when an electron from an ion that diffuses across the layer is snapped over the activation barrier and on to the electrode. No flow of current can exceed the limitingcurrentdensity, jlim, which is given by jlim = zFJlim = (25.57a) By using the Nernst–Einstein equation (eqn 21.65, written as D = RTλ/z2 F2 ), we can express jlim in terms of the ionic conductivity λ: jlim = (25.57b) Illustration 25.3 Estimating the limiting current density Consider an electrode in a 0.10 M Cu2+ (aq) unstirred solution in which the thickness of the diffusion layer is about 0.3 mm. With λ = 107 S cm2 mol−1 (Table 21.4), δ = 0.3 mm, c = 0.10 mol dm−3 , z = 2, and T = 298 K, it follows from eqn 25.57b that jlim = 5 mA cm−2 . The result implies that the current towards an electrode of area 1 cm2 electrode cannot exceed 5 mA in this (unstirred) solution. Self-test 25.8 Evaluate the limiting current density for an Ag(s)|Ag+ (aq) electrode in 0.010 mol dm−3 Ag+ (aq) at 298 K. Take δ = 0.03 mm. [5 mA cm−2 ] It follows from eqn 25.56 that the concentration c′ is related to the current density at the double layer by c′ = c − (25.58) Hence, as the current density is increased, the concentration falls below the bulk value. However, this decline in concentration is small when the diffusion constant is large, for then the ions are very mobile and can quickly replenish any ions that have been removed. Finally, we substitute eqn 25.58 into eqn 25.52 and obtain the following expressions for the overpotential in terms of the current density, and vice versa: ηc = ln 1 − (25.59a) j = (1 − ezfηc ) (25.59b) (b) Experimental techniques The kind of output from linear-sweep voltammetry is illustrated in Fig. 25.43. Initially, the absolute value of the potential is low, and the cathodic current is due to the zcFD δ D F jδ zcFD A C RT zF jδ zFD cRTλ zFδ zFDc δ c − c′ δ 25.10 VOLTAMMETRY 943 migration of ions in the solution. However, as the potential approaches the reduction potential of the reducible solute, the cathodic current grows. Soon after the potential exceeds the reduction potential the current rises and reaches a maximum value (as specified in eqn 25.57). This maximum current is proportional to the molar concentration of the species, so that concentration can be determined from the peak height after subtraction of an extrapolated baseline. In differential pulse voltammetry the current is monitored before and after a pulse of potential is applied, and the processed output is the slope of a curve like that obtained by linear-sweep voltammetry (Fig. 25.44). The area under the curve (in effect, the integral of the derivative displayed in the illustration) is proportional to the concentration of the species. In cyclic voltammetry the potential is applied in a sawtooth manner to the working electrode and the current is monitored. A typical cyclic voltammogram is shown in Fig. 25.45. The shape of the curve is initially like that of a linear sweep experiment, but after reversal of the sweep there is a rapid change in current on account of the high concentration of oxidizable species close to the electrode that were generated on the reductive sweep. When the potential is close to the value required to oxidize the reduced species, there is a substantial anodic current until all the oxidation is complete, and the current returns to zero. When the reduction reaction at the electrode can be reversed, as in the case of the [Fe(CN)6]3− /[Fe(CN)6]4− couple, the cyclic voltammogram is broadly symmetric about the standard potential of the couple (as in Fig. 25.45b). The scan is initiated with [Fe(CN)6]3− present in solution and, as the potential approaches E7 for the couple, the [Fe(CN)6]3− near the electrode is reduced and current begins to flow. As the potential continues to change, the cathodic current begins to decline again because all Fig. 25.43 The change of potential with time and the resulting current/potential curve in a voltammetry experiment. The peak value of the current density is proportional to the concentration of electroactive species (for instance, [Ox]) in solution. Fig. 25.45 (a) The change of potential with time and (b) the resulting current/potential curve in a cyclic voltammetry experiment. Fig. 25.44 A differential pulse voltammetry experiment. (a) The potential is swept linearly as a mercury droplet grows on the end of a capillary dipping into the sample and then pulsed as shown by the purple line. The resulting current is shown as the blue line and is sampled at the two points shown. (b) The data output is obtained as the difference of the currents at the two sampled points. 944 25 PROCESSES AT SOLID SURFACES Fig. 25.46 (a) When a non-reversible step in a reaction mechanism has time to occur, the cyclic voltammogram may not show the reverse oxidation or reduction peak. (b) However, if the rate of sweep is increased, the return step may be caused to occur before the irreversible step has had time to intervene, and a typical ‘reversible’ voltammogram is obtained. Fig. 25.47 The cyclic voltammogram referred to in Self-test 25.9. the [Fe(CN)6]3− near the electrode has been reduced and the current reaches its limiting value. The potential is now returned linearly to its initial value, and the reverse series of events occurs with the [Fe(CN)6]4− produced during the forward scan now undergoing oxidation. The peak of current lies on the other side of E7 , so the species present and its standard potential can be identified, as indicated in the illustration, by noting the locations of the two peaks. The overall shape of the curve gives details of the kinetics of the electrode process and the change in shape as the rate of change of potential is altered gives information on the rates of the processes involved. For example, the matching peak on the return phase of the sawtooth change of potential may be missing, which indicates that the oxidation (or reduction) is irreversible. The appearance of the curve may also depend on the timescale of the sweep for, if the sweep is too fast, some processes might not have time to occur. This style of analysis is illustrated in the following example. Example 25.5 Analysing a cyclic voltammetry experiment The electroreduction of p-bromonitrobenzene in liquid ammonia is believed to occur by the following mechanism: BrC6H4NO2 + e− → BrC6H4NO2 − BrC6H4NO2 − → ·C6H4NO2 + Br− ·C6H4NO2 + e− → C6H4NO2 − C6H4NO2 − + H+ → C6H5NO2 Suggest the likely form of the cyclic voltammogram expected on the basis of this mechanism. Method Decide which steps are likely to be reversible on the timescale of the potential sweep: such processes will give symmetrical voltammograms. Irreversible processes will give unsymmetrical shapes because reduction (or oxidation) might not occur. However, at fast sweep rates, an intermediate might not have time to react, and a reversible shape will be observed. Answer At slow sweep rates, the second reaction has time to occur, and a curve typical of a two-electron reduction will be observed, but there will be no oxidation peak on the second half of the cycle because the product, C6H5NO2, cannot be oxidized (Fig. 25.46a). At fast sweep rates, the second reaction does not have time to take place before oxidation of the BrC6H4NO2 − intermediate starts to occur during the reverse scan, so the voltammogram will be typical of a reversible oneelectron reduction (Fig. 25.46b). Self-test 25.9 Suggest an interpretation of the cyclic voltammogram shown in Fig. 25.47. The electroactive material is ClC6H4CN in acid solution; after reduction to ClC6H4CN− , the radical anion may form C6H5CN irreversibly. [ClC6H4CN + e− 5 ClC6H4CN− , ClC6H4CN− + H+ + e− → C6H5CN + Cl− , C6H5CN + e− 5 C6H5CN− ] 25.11 Electrolysis To induce current to flow through an electrolytic cell and bring about a nonspontaneous cell reaction, the applied potential difference must exceed the zero-current potential by at least the cell overpotential. The cell overpotential is the sum of the overpotentials at the two electrodes and the ohmic drop (IRs, where Rs is the internal 25.12 WORKING GALVANIC CELLS 945 resistance of the cell) due to the current through the electrolyte. The additional potential needed to achieve a detectable rate of reaction may need to be large when the exchange current density at the electrodes is small. For similar reasons, a working galvanic cell generates a smaller potential than under zero-current conditions. In this section we see how to cope with both aspects of the overpotential. The relative rates of gas evolution or metal deposition during electrolysis can be estimated from the Butler–Volmer equation and tables of exchange current densities. From eqn 25.46 and assuming equal transfer coefficients, we write the ratio of the cathodic currents as = e(η−η′)αf (25.60) where j′ is the current density for electrodeposition and j is that for gas evolution, and j′0 and j0 are the corresponding exchange current densities. This equation shows that metal deposition is favoured by a large exchange current density and relatively high gas evolution overpotential (so η− η′ is positive and large). Note that η< 0 for a cathodic process, so −η′ > 0. The exchange current density depends strongly on the nature of the electrode surface, and changes in the course of the electrodeposition of one metal on another. A very crude criterion is that significant evolution or deposition occurs only if the overpotential exceeds about 0.6 V. Self-test 25.10 Deduce an expression for the ratio when the hydrogen evolution is limited by transport across a diffusion layer. [j′/j = (δj′0/cFD)e−αη′f ] A glance at Table 25.6 shows the wide range of exchange current densities for a metal/hydrogen electrode. The most sluggish exchange currents occur for lead and mercury, and the value of 1 pA cm−2 corresponds to a monolayer of atoms being replaced in about 5 years. For such systems, a high overpotential is needed to induce significant hydrogen evolution. In contrast, the value for platinum (1 mA cm−2 ) corresponds to a monolayer being replaced in 0.1 s, so gas evolution occurs for a much lower overpotential. The exchange current density also depends on the crystal face exposed. For the deposition of copper on copper, the (100) face has j0 = 1 mA cm−2 , so for the same overpotential the (100) face grows at 2.5 times the rate of the (111) face, for which j0 = 0.4 mA cm−2 . 25.12 Working galvanic cells In working galvanic cells (those not balanced against an external potential), the overpotential leads to a smaller potential than under zero-current conditions. Furthermore, we expect the cell potential to decrease as current is generated because it is then no longer working reversibly and can therefore do less than maximum work. We shall consider the cell M|M+ (aq)||M′+ (aq)|M′ and ignore all the complications arising from liquid junctions. The potential of the cell is E′ = ∆φR − ∆φL. Because the cell potential differences differ from their zero-current values by overpotentials, we can write ∆φX = EX + ηX, where X is L or R for the left or right electrode, respectively. The cell potential is therefore E′ = E + ηR − ηL (25.61a) j′0 j0 j′ j 946 25 PROCESSES AT SOLID SURFACES To avoid confusion about signs (ηR is negative, ηL is positive) and to emphasize that a working cell has a lower potential than a zero-current cell, we shall write this expression as E′ = E − |ηR| − |ηL| (25.61b) with E the cell emf. We should also subtract the ohmic potential difference IRs, where Rs is the cell’s internal resistance: E′ = E − |ηR| − |ηL| − IRs (25.61c) The ohmic term is a contribution to the cell’s irreversibility—it is a thermal dissipation term—so the sign of IRs is always such as to reduce the potential in the direction of zero. The overpotentials in eqn 25.61 can be calculated from the Butler–Volmer equation for a given current, I, being drawn. We shall simplify the equations by supposing that the areas, A, of the electrodes are the same, that only one electron is transferred in the rate-determining steps at the electrodes, that the transfer coefficients are both 1 –2, and that the high-overpotential limit of the Butler–Volmer equation may be used. Then from eqns 25.46 and 25.61c we find E′ = E − IRs − ln H = (j0L j0R)1/2 (25.62) where j0L and j0R are the exchange current densities for the two electrodes. The concentration overpotential also reduces the cell potential. If we use the Nernst diffusion layer model for each electrode, the total change of potential arising from concentration polarization is given by eqn 25.59 as E′ = E − ln 1 − 1 − (25.63) This contribution can be added to the one in eqn 25.62 to obtain a full (but still very approximate) expression for the cell potential when a current I is being drawn: E′ = E − IRs − ln g(I) (25.64a) with g(I) = 2z 1 − 1 − 1/2 (25.64b) This equation depends on a lot of parameters, but an example of its general form is given in Fig. 25.48. Notice the very steep decline of working potential when the current is high and close to the limiting value for one of the electrodes. Because the power, P, supplied by a galvanic cell is IE′, from eqn 25.64 we can write P = IE − I2 Rs − ln g(I) (25.65) The first term on the right is the power that would be produced if the cell retained its zero-current potential when delivering current. The second term is the power generated uselessly as heat as a result of the resistance of the electrolyte. The third term is the reduction of the potential at the electrodes as a result of drawing current. The general dependence of power output on the current drawn is shown in Fig. 25.48 as the purple line. Notice how maximum power is achieved just before the concentration polarization quenches the cell’s performance. Information of this kind is essential if the optimum conditions for operating electrochemical devices are to be found and their performance improved. 2IRT zF 5 6 7 D F I Ajlim,R A C D F I Ajlim,L A C 1 2 3 D F I AH A C 2RT zF 5 6 7 D F I Ajlim,R A C D F I Ajlim,L A C 1 2 3 RT zF D F I AH A C 4RT F Fig. 25.48 The dependence of the potential of a working galvanic cell on the current density being drawn (blue line) and the corresponding power output (purple line) calculated by using eqns 25.64 and 25.65, respectively. Notice the sharp decline in power just after the maximum. Exploration Using mathematical software, and electronic spreadsheet, or the interactive applets found in the Living graphs section of the text’s web site, confirm that the sharp decline in potential and power observed in Fig. 25.48 is true for any value of Rs. I25.13 IMPACT ON TECHNOLOGY: FUEL CELLS 947 Electric storage cells operate as galvanic cells while they are producing electricity but as electrolytic cells while they are being charged by an external supply. The lead– acid battery is an old device, but one well suited to the job of starting cars (and the only one available). During charging the cathode reaction is the reduction of Pb2+ and its deposition as lead on the lead electrode. Deposition occurs instead of the reduction of the acid to hydrogen because the latter has a low exchange current density on lead. The anode reaction during charging is the oxidation of Pb(II) to Pb(IV), which is deposited as the oxide PbO2. On discharge, the two reactions run in reverse. Because they have such high exchange current densities the discharge can occur rapidly, which is why the lead battery can produce large currents on demand. IMPACT ON TECHNOLOGY I25.3 Fuel cells A fuel cell operates like a conventional galvanic cell with the exception that the reactants are supplied from outside rather than forming an integral part of its construction. A fundamental and important example of a fuel cell is the hydrogen/oxygen cell, such as the ones used in space missions (Fig. 25.49). One of the electrolytes used is concentrated aqueous potassium hydroxide maintained at 200°C and 20–40 atm; the electrodes may be porous nickel in the form of sheets of compressed powder. The cathode reaction is the reduction O2(g) + 2 H2O(l) + 4 e− → 4 OH− (aq) E7 = +0.40 V and the anode reaction is the oxidation H2(g) + 2 OH− (aq) → 2 H2O(l) + 2 e− For the corresponding reduction, E7 = −0.83 V. Because the overall reaction 2 H2(g) + O2(g) → 2 H2O(l) E7 = +1.23 V is exothermic as well as spontaneous, it is less favourable thermodynamically at 200°C than at 25°C, so the cell potential is lower at the higher temperature. However, the increased pressure compensates for the increased temperature, and E ≈ +1.2 V at 200°C and 40 atm. One advantage of the hydrogen/oxygen system is the large exchange current density of the hydrogen reaction. Unfortunately, the oxygen reaction has an exchange current density of only about 0.1 nA cm−2 , which limits the current available from the cell. One way round the difficulty is to use a catalytic surface (to increase j0) with a large surface area. One type of highly developed fuel cell has phosphoric acid as the electrolyte and operates with hydrogen and air at about 200°C; the hydrogen is obtained from a reforming reaction on natural gas: Anode: 2 H2(g) → 4 H+ (aq) + 4 e− Cathode: O2(g) + 4 H+ (aq) + 4 e− → 2 H2O(l) This fuel cell has shown promise for combined heat and power systems (CHP systems). In such systems, the waste heat is used to heat buildings or to do work. Efficiency in a CHP plant can reach 80 per cent. The power output of batteries of such cells has reached the order of 10 MW. Although hydrogen gas is an attractive fuel, it has disadvantages for mobile applications: it is difficult to store and dangerous to handle. One possibility for portable fuel cells is to store the hydrogen in carbon nanotubes (Impact 20.2). It has been shown that carbon nanofibres in herringbone patterns can store huge amounts of hydrogen and result in an energy density (the magnitude of the released energy divided by the volume of the material) twice that of gasoline. Cells with molten carbonate electrolytes at about 600°C can make use of natural gas directly. Solid-state electrolytes are also used. They include one version in which the Fig. 25.49 A single cell of a hydrogen/oxygen fuel cell. In practice, a stack of many cells is used. 948 25 PROCESSES AT SOLID SURFACES electrolyte is a solid polymeric ionic conductor at about 100°C, but in current versions it requires very pure hydrogen to operate successfully. Solid ionic conducting oxide cells operate at about 1000°C and can use hydrocarbons directly as fuel. Until these materials have been developed, one attractive fuel is methanol, which is easy to handle and is rich in hydrogen atoms: Anode: CH3OH(l) + 6 OH− (aq) → 5 H2O(l) + CO2(g) + 6 e− Cathode: O2(g) + 4 e− + 2 H2O(l) → 4 OH− (aq) One disadvantage of methanol, however, is the phenomenon of ‘electro-osmotic drag’ in which protons moving through the polymer electrolyte membrane separating the anode and cathode carry water and methanol with them into the cathode compartment where the potential is sufficient to oxidize CH3OH to CO2, so reducing the efficiency of the cell. Solid ionic conducting oxide cells operate at about 1000°C and can use hydrocarbons directly as fuel. A biofuel cell is like a conventional fuel cell but in place of a platinum catalyst it uses enzymes or even whole organisms. The electricity will be extracted through organic molecules that can support the transfer of electrons. One application will be as the power source for medical implants, such as pacemakers, perhaps using the glucose present in the bloodstream as the fuel. 25.13 Corrosion A thermodynamic warning of the likelihood of corrosion is obtained by comparing the standard potentials of the metal reduction, such as Fe2+ (aq) + 2 e− → Fe(s) E 7 = −0.44 V with the values for one of the following half-reactions: In acidic solution: (a) 2 H+ (aq) + 2 e− → H2(g) E 7 = 0 (b) 4 H+ (aq) + O2(g) + 4 e− → 2 H2O(l) E7 = +1.23 V In basic solution: (c) 2 H2O(l) + O2(g) + 4 e− → 4 OH− (aq) E 7 = +0.40 V Because all three redox couples have standard potentials more positive than E 7 (Fe2+ /Fe), all three can drive the oxidation of iron to iron(II). The electrode potentials we have quoted are standard values, and they change with the pH of the medium. For the first two: E(a) = E7 (a) + (RT/F)ln a(H+ ) = −(0.059 V)pH E(b) = E 7 (b) + (RT/F)ln a(H+ ) = 1.23 V − (0.059 V)pH These expressions let us judge at what pH the iron will have a tendency to oxidize (see Chapter 7). A thermodynamic discussion of corrosion, however, only indicates whether a tendency to corrode exists. If there is a thermodynamic tendency, we must examine the kinetics of the processes involved to see whether the process occurs at a significant rate. A model of a corrosion system is shown in Fig. 25.50a. It can be taken to be a drop of slightly acidic (or basic) water containing some dissolved oxygen in contact with the metal. The oxygen at the edges of the droplet, where the O2 concentration is higher, is reduced by electrons donated by the iron over an area A. Those electrons are replaced by others released elsewhere as Fe → Fe2+ + 2 e− . This oxidative release occurs over an area A′ under the oxygen-deficient inner region of the droplet. The droplet acts as a short-circuited galvanic cell (Fig. 25.50b). I25.4 IMPACT ON TECHNOLOGY: PROTECTING MATERIALS AGAINST CORROSION 949 The rate of corrosion is measured by the current of metal ions leaving the metal surface in the anodic region. This flux of ions gives rise to the corrosion current, Icorr, which can be identified with the anodic current, Ia. We show in the justification below that the corrosion current is related to the cell potential of the corrosion couple by Icorr = H0AefE/4 H0 = (j0j0′)1/2 A = (AA′)1/2 (25.66) Justification 25.1 The corrosion current Because any current emerging from the anodic region must find its way to the cathodic region, the cathodic current, Ic, and the anodic current, Ia, must both be equal to the corrosion current. In terms of the current densities at the oxidation and reduction sites, j and j′, respectively, we can write Icorr = jA = j′A′ = (jj′AA′)1/2 = HA H = (jj′)1/2 A = (AA′)1/2 (25.67) The Butler–Volmer equation is now used to express the current densities in terms of overpotentials. For simplicity we assume that the overpotentials are large enough for the high-overpotential limit (eqn 25.46, j = −j0e−αfη ) to apply, that polarization overpotential can be neglected, that the rate-determining step is the transfer of a single electron, and that the transfer coefficients are 1–2. We also assume that, since the droplet is so small, there is negligible potential difference between the cathode and anode regions of the solution. Moreover, because it is short-circuited by the metal, the potential of the metal is the same in both regions, and so the potential difference between the metal and the solution is the same in both regions too; it is denoted ∆φcorr. The overpotentials in the two regions are therefore η = ∆φcorr − ∆φ and η′ = ∆φcorr − ∆φ′, and the current densities are j = j0eηf/2 = j0ef∆φcorr/2 e−f∆φ/2 j′ = j′0e−η′f/2 = j′0e−f∆φcorr/2 ef∆φ′/2 These expressions can be substituted into the expression for Icorr and ∆φ′ − ∆φ replaced by the difference of electrode potentials E to give eqn 25.66. The effect of the exchange current density on the corrosion rate can be seen by considering the specific case of iron in contact with acidified water. Thermodynamically, either hydrogen or oxygen reduction reaction (a) or (b) on p. 946 is effective. However, the exchange current density of reaction (b) on iron is only about 10−14 A cm−2 , whereas for (a) it is 10−6 A cm−2 . The latter therefore dominates kinetically, and iron corrodes by hydrogen evolution in acidic solution. For corrosion reactions with similar exchange current densities, eqn 25.66 predicts that the rate of corrosion is high when E is large. That is, rapid corrosion can be expected when the oxidizing and reducing couples have widely differing electrode potentials. IMPACT ON TECHNOLOGY I25.4 Protecting materials against corrosion Several techniques for inhibiting corrosion are available. First, from eqn 25.66 we see that the rate of corrosion depends on the surfaces exposed: if either A or A′ is zero, then the corrosion current is zero. This interpretation points to a trivial, yet often effective, method of slowing corrosion: cover the surface with some impermeable layer, such as paint, which prevents access of damp air. Paint also increases the effective solution resistance between the cathode and anode patches on the surface. Unfortunately, this protection fails disastrously if the paint becomes porous. The oxygen then has access to the exposed metal and corrosion continues beneath the paintwork. Another form of surface coating is provided by galvanizing, the coating of an iron object with zinc. Because the latter’s standard potential is −0.76 V, which is more negative than that of the iron couple, the corrosion of zinc is thermodynamically Fig. 25.50 (a) A simple version of the corrosion process is that of a droplet of water, which is oxygen rich near its boundary with air. The oxidation of the iron takes place in the region away from the oxygen because the electrons are transported through the metal. (b) The process may be modelled as a shortcircuited electrochemical cell. 950 25 PROCESSES AT SOLID SURFACES favoured and the iron survives (the zinc survives because it is protected by a hydrated oxide layer). In contrast, tin plating leads to a very rapid corrosion of the iron once its surface is scratched and the iron exposed because the tin couple (E7 = −0.14 V) oxidizes the iron couple (E 7 = −0.44 V). Some oxides are inert kinetically in the sense that they adhere to the metal surface and form an impermeable layer over a fairly wide pH range. This passivation, or kinetic protection, can be seen as a way of decreasing the exchange currents by sealing the surface. Thus, aluminium is inert in air even though its standard potential is strongly negative (−1.66 V). Another method of protection is to change the electric potential of the object by pumping in electrons that can be used to satisfy the demands of the oxygen reduction without involving the oxidation of the metal. In cathodic protection, the object is connected to a metal with a more negative standard potential (such as magnesium, −2.36 V). The magnesium acts as a sacrificial anode, supplying its own electrons to the iron and becoming oxidized to Mg2+ in the process (Fig. 25.51a). A block of magnesium replaced occasionally is much cheaper than the ship, building, or pipeline for which it is being sacrificed. In impressed-currentcathodicprotection (Fig. 25.51b) anexternalcellsuppliestheelectronsandeliminatestheneedforirontotransferitsown. Fig. 25.51 (a) In cathodic protection an anode of a more strongly reducing metal is sacrificed to maintain the integrity of the protected object (for example, a pipeline, bridge, or boat). (b) In impressed-current cathodic protection electrons are supplied from an external cell so that the object itself is not oxidized. The broken lines depict the completed circuit through the soil. Table 25.7 Summary of acronyms AES Auger electron spectroscopy AFM Atomic force microscopy BET isotherm Brunauer–Emmett–Teller isotherm EELS Electron energy-loss spectroscopy ER mechanism Eley–Rideal mechanism ESCA Electron spectroscopy for chemical analysis FIM Field-ionization microscopy HREELS High-resolution electron energy-loss spectroscopy IHP Inner Helmholtz plane LEED Low-energy electron diffraction LH mechanism Langmuir–Hinshelwood mechanism MBRS Molecular beam reactive scattering MBS Molecular beam scattering OHP Outer Helmholtz plane QCM Quartz crystal microbalance RAIRS Reflection–absorption infrared spectroscopy SAM Scanning Auger electron microscopy SAM Self-assembled monolayer SEM Scanning electron microscopy SERS Surface-enhanced Raman scattering SEXAFS Surface-extended X-ray absorption fine structure spectroscopy SHG Second harmonic generation SIMS Secondary ion mass spectrometry SPM Scanning probe microscopy SPR Surface plasmon resonance STM Scanning tunnelling microscopy TDS Thermal desorption spectroscopy TPD Temperature programmed desorption UHV Ultra-high vacuum UPS Ultraviolet photoemission spectroscopy XPS X-ray photoemission spectroscopy FURTHER READING 951 Further reading Articles and texts A.W. Adamson and A. Gast, Physical chemistry of surfaces. Wiley, New York (1997). A.J. Bard and L.R. Faulkner, Electrochemical methods: fundamentals and applications. Wiley, New York (2000). J.O’M. Bockris, R.E. White, and B.E. Conway (ed.), Modern aspects of electrochemistry. Vol. 33. Plenum, New York (1999). G. Ertl, H. Knözinger, and J. Weitkamp, Handbook of heterogeneous catalysis. VCH, Weinheim (1997). M.G. Fontanna and R.W. Staehle (ed.), Advances in corrosion science and technology. Plenum, New York (1980). C.H. Hamann, W. Vielstich, and A. Hammett, Electrochemistry. Wiley–VCH, New York (1998). J.C. Lindon, G.E. Tranter, and J.L. Holmes (ed.), Encyclopedia of spectroscopy and spectrometry. Academic Press, San Diego (2000). N. Mizuno and M. Misono, Heterogeneous catalysis. Chem. Rev. 98, 199 (1998). G.A. Somorjai, Modern surface science and surface technologies: an introduction. Chem. Rev. 96, 1223 (1996). Checklist of key ideas 1. Adsorption is the attachment of molecules to a surface; the substance that adsorbs is the adsorbate and the underlying material is the adsorbent or substrate. The reverse of adsorption is desorption. 2. The collision flux, ZW, of gas molecules bombarding a solid surface is related to the gas pressure by ZW = p/(2πmkT)1/2 . 3. Techniques for studying surface composition and structure include scanning electron microscopy (SEM), scanning probe microscopy (STM), photoemission spectroscopy, sescondaryion mass spectrometry, surface-enhanced Raman scattering (SERS), Auger electron spectroscopy (AES), low energy electron diffraction (LEED), and molecular beam scattering (MBS). 4. The fractional coverage, θ, is the ratio of the number of occupied sites to the number of available sites. 5. Techniques for studying the rates of surface processes include flash desorption, biosensor analysis, second harmonic generation (SHG), gravimetry by using a quartz crystal microbalance (QCM), and molecular beam reactive scattering (MRS). 6. Physisorption is adsorption by a van der Waals interaction; chemisorption is adsorption by formation of a chemical (usually covalent) bond. 7. The Langmuir isotherm is a relation between the fractional coverage and the partial pressure of the adsorbate: θ = Kp/(1 + Kp). 8. The isosteric enthalpy of adsorption is determined from a plot of ln K against 1/T. 9. The BET isotherm is an isotherm applicable when multilayer adsorption is possible: V/Vmon = cz/(1 − z){1 − (1 − c)z}, with z = p/p*. 10. The sticking probability, s, is the proportion of collisions with the surface that successfully lead to adsorption. 11. Desorption is an activated process with half-life t1/2 = τ0eEd/RT ; the desorption activation energy is measured by temperatureprogrammed desorption (TPD) or thermal desorption spectroscopy (TDS). 12. In the Langmuir–Hinshelwood mechanism (LH mechanism) of surface-catalysed reactions, the reaction takes place by encounters between molecular fragments and atoms adsorbed on the surface. 13. In the Eley–Rideal mechanism (ER mechanism) of a surfacecatalysed reaction, a gas-phase molecule collides with another molecule already adsorbed on the surface. 14. An electrical double layer consists of a sheet of positive charge at the surface of the electrode and a sheet of negative charge next to it in the solution (or vice versa). 15. The Galvani potential difference is the potential difference between the bulk of the metal electrode and the bulk of the solution. 16. Models of the double layer include the Helmholtz layer model and the Gouy–Chapman model. 17. The current density, j, at an electrode is expressed by the Butler–Volmer equation, j = j0{e(1−α)fη − e−αfη }, where η is the overpotential, η = E′ − E, α is the transfer coefficient, and j0 is the exchange-current density. 18. A Tafel plot is a plot of the logarithm of the current density against the overpotential: the slope gives the value of α and the intercept at η = 0 gives the exchange-current density. 19. Voltammetry is the study of the current through an electrode as a function of the applied potential difference. Experimental techniques include linear-sweep voltammetry, differential pulse voltammetry, and cyclic voltammetry. 20. To induce current to flow through an electrolytic cell and bring about a nonspontaneous cell reaction, the applied potential difference must exceed the cell emf by at least the cell overpotential. 21. The corrosion current is a current proportional to the rate at which metal ions leave a metal surface in the anodic region during corrosion. 952 25 PROCESSES AT SOLID SURFACES Discussion questions 25.1 (a) Distinguish between a step and a terrace. (b) Describe how steps and terraces can be formed by dislocations. 25.2 (a) Describe the advantages and limitations of each of the spectroscopic techniques designated by the acronyms AES, EELS, HREELS, RAIRS, SERS, SEXAFS, SHG, UPS, and XPS. (b) Describe the advantages and limitations of each of the microscopy, diffraction, and scattering techniques designated by the acronyms AFM, FIM, LEED, MBRS, MBS, SAM, SEM, and STM. 25.3 Distinguish between the following adsorption isotherms: Langmuir, BET, Temkin, and Freundlich. C.D.S. Tuck, Modern battery construction. Ellis Horwood, New York (1991). J. Vickerman, Surface analysis: techniques and applications. Wiley, New York (1997). Sources of data and information C.M.A. Brett and A.M.O. Brett, Electrode potentials. Oxford Chemistry Primers, Oxford University Press (1998). D. Linden (ed.), Handbook of batteries and cells. McGraw-Hill, New York (1984). Further information Further information 25.1 The relation between electrode potential and the Galvani potential To demonstrate the relation between ∆φ and E, consider the cell Pt|H2(g)|H+ (g)||M+ (aq)|M(s) and the half-reactions M+ (aq) + e− → M(s) H+ (aq) + e− → 1–2 H2(g) The Gibbs energies of these two half-reactions can be expressed in terms of the chemical potentials, µ, of all the species. However, we must take into account the fact that the species are present in phases with different electric potentials. Thus, a cation in a region of positive potential has a higher chemical potential (is chemically more active in a thermodynamic sense) than in a region of zero potential. The contribution of an electric potential to the chemical potential is calculated by noting that the electrical work of adding a charge ze to a region where the potential is φ is zeφ, and therefore that the work per mole is zFφ, where F is Faraday’s constant. Because at constant temperature and pressure the maximum electrical work can be identified with the change in Gibbs energy (Section 7.7), the difference in chemical potential of an ion with and without the electrical potential present is zFφ. The chemical potential of an ion in the presence of an electric potential is called its electrochemical potential, G. It follows that G = µ + zFφ [25.68] where µ is the chemical potential of the species when the electrical potential is zero. When z = 0 (a neutral species), the electrochemical potential is equal to the chemical potential. To express the Gibbs energy for the half-reactions in terms of the electrochemical potentials of the species we note that the cations M+ are in the solution where the inner potential is φS and the electrons are in the electrode where it is φM. It follows that ∆rGR = G(M) − {G(M+ ) + G(e− )} = µ(M) − {µ(M+ ) + FφS + µ(e− ) − FφM} = µ(M) − µ(M+ ) − µ(e− ) + F∆φR where ∆φR = φM − φS is the Galvani potential difference at the righthand electrode. Likewise, in the hydrogen half-reaction, the electrons are in the platinum electrode at a potential φPt and the H+ ions are in the solution where the potential is φS: ∆rGL = 1 –2G(H2) − {G(H+ ) + G(e− )} = 1–2 µ(H2) − µ(H+ ) − µ(e− ) + F∆φL where ∆φL = φPt − φS is the Galvani potential difference at the lefthand electrode. The overall reaction Gibbs energy is ∆rGR − ∆rGL = µ(M) + µ(H+ ) − µ(M+ ) − 1–2 µ(H2) + F(∆φR − ∆φL) = ∆rG + F(∆φR − ∆φL) where ∆rG is the Gibbs energy of the cell reaction. When the cell is balanced against an external source of potential the entire system is at equilibrium. The overall reaction Gibbs energy is then zero (because its tendency to change is balanced against the external source of potential and overall there is stalemate), and the last equation becomes 0 = ∆rG + F(∆φR − ∆φL) which rearranges to ∆rG = −F(∆φR − ∆φL) (25.69) If we compare this with the result established in Section 7.7 that ∆rG = −FE and E = ER − EL, we can conclude that (ignoring the effects of any metal–platinum and liquid junction potentials that may be present in an actual cell) ER − EL = ∆φR − ∆φL (25.70) This is the result we wanted to show, for it implies that the Galvani potential difference at each electrode can differ from the electrode potential by a constant at most; that constant cancels when the difference is taken. EXERCISES 953 25.4 Consider the analysis of surface plasmon resonance data (as in biosensor analysis) and discuss how a plot of a0/Req against a0 may be used to evaluate Rmax and K. 25.5 Describe the essential features of the Langmuir–Hinshelwood, Eley–Rideal, and Mars van Krevelen mechanisms for surface-catalysed reactions. 25.6 Account for the dependence of catalytic activity of a surface on the strength of chemisorption, as shown in Fig. 25.28. 25.7 Discuss the unique physical and chemical properties of zeolites that make them useful heterogeneous catalysts. 25.8 (a) Discuss the main structural features of the electrical double layer. (b) Distinguish between the electrical double layer and the Nernst diffusion layer. 25.9 Define the terms in and limit the generality of the following expressions: (a) j = j0fη, (b) j = j0e(1−α)fη , and (c) j = −j0e−αfη . 25.10 Discuss the technique of cyclic voltammetry and account for the characteristic shape of a cyclic voltammogram, such as those shown in Figs. 25.45 and 25.46. 25.11 Discuss the principles of operation of a fuel cell. 25.12 Discuss the chemical origins of corrosion and useful strategies for preventing it. Exercises 25.1a Calculate the frequency of molecular collisions per square centimetre of surface in a vessel containing (a) hydrogen, (b) propane at 25°C when the pressure is (i) 100 Pa, (ii) 0.10 µTorr. 25.1b Calculate the frequency of molecular collisions per square centimetre of surface in a vessel containing (a) nitrogen, (b) methane at 25°C when the pressure is (i) 10.0 Pa, (ii) 0.150 µTorr. 25.2a What pressure of argon gas is required to produce a collision rate of 4.5 × 1020 s−1 at 425 K on a circular surface of diameter 1.5 mm? 25.2b What pressure of nitrogen gas is required to produce a collision rate of 5.00 × 1019 s−1 at 525 K on a circular surface of diameter 2.0 mm? 25.3a Calculate the average rate at which He atoms strike a Cu atom in a surface formed by exposing a (100) plane in metallic copper to helium gas at 80 K and a pressure of 35 Pa. Crystals of copper are face-centred cubic with a cell edge of 361 pm. 25.3b Calculate the average rate at which He atoms strike an iron atom in a surface formed by exposing a (100) plane in metallic iron to helium gas at 100 K and a pressure of 24 Pa. Crystals of iron are body-centred cubic with a cell edge of 145 pm. 25.4a A monolayer of N2 molecules (effective area 0.165 nm2 ) is adsorbed on the surface of 1.00 g of an Fe/Al2O3 catalyst at 77 K, the boiling point of liquid nitrogen. Upon warming, the nitrogen occupies 2.86 cm3 at 0°C and 760 Torr. What is the surface area of the catalyst? 25.4b A monolayer of CO molecules (effective area 0.165 nm2 ) is adsorbed on the surface of 1.00 g of an Fe/Al2O3 catalyst at 77 K, the boiling point of liquid nitrogen. Upon warming, the carbon monoxide occupies 4.25 cm3 at 0°C and 1.00 bar. What is the surface area of the catalyst? 25.5a The volume of oxygen gas at 0°C and 101 kPa adsorbed on the surface of 1.00 g of a sample of silica at 0°C was 0.284 cm3 at 142.4 Torr and 1.430 cm3 at 760 Torr. What is the value of Vmon? 25.5b The volume of gas at 20°C and 1.00 bar adsorbed on the surface of 1.50 g of a sample of silica at 0°C was 1.60 cm3 at 52.4 kPa and 2.73 cm3 at 104 kPa. What is the value of Vmon? 25.6a The enthalpy of adsorption of CO on a surface is found to be −120 kJ mol−1 . Estimate the mean lifetime of a CO molecule on the surface at 400 K. 25.6b The enthalpy of adsorption of ammonia on a nickel surface is found to be −155 kJ mol−1 . Estimate the mean lifetime of an NH3 molecule on the surface at 500 K. 25.7a The average time for which an oxygen atom remains adsorbed to a tungsten surface is 0.36 s at 2548 K and 3.49 s at 2362 K. Find the activation energy for desorption. What is the pre-exponential factor for these tightly chemisorbed atoms? 25.7b The chemisorption of hydrogen on manganese is activated, but only weakly so. Careful measurements have shown that it proceeds 35 per cent faster at 1000 K than at 600 K. What is the activation energy for chemisorption? 25.8a The adsorption of a gas is described by the Langmuir isotherm with K = 0.85 kPa−1 at 25°C. Calculate the pressure at which the fractional surface coverage is (a) 0.15, (b) 0.95. 25.8b The adsorption of a gas is described by the Langmuir isotherm with K = 0.777 kPa−1 at 25°C. Calculate the pressure at which the fractional surface coverage is (a) 0.20, (b) 0.75. 25.9a A certain solid sample adsorbs 0.44 mg of CO when the pressure of the gas is 26.0 kPa and the temperature is 300 K. The mass of gas adsorbed when the pressure is 3.0 kPa and the temperature is 300 K is 0.19 mg. The Langmuir isotherm is known to describe the adsorption. Find the fractional coverage of the surface at the two pressures. 25.9b A certain solid sample adsorbs 0.63 mg of CO when the pressure of the gas is 36.0 kPa and the temperature is 300 K. The mass of gas adsorbed when the pressure is 4.0 kPa and the temperature is 300 K is 0.21 mg. The Langmuir isotherm is known to describe the adsorption. Find the fractional coverage of the surface at the two pressures. 25.10a For how long on average would an H atom remain on a surface at 298 K if its desorption activation energy were (a) 15 kJ mol−1 , (b) 150 kJ mol−1 ? Take τ0 = 0.10 ps. For how long on average would the same atoms remain at 1000 K? 25.10b For how long on average would an atom remain on a surface at 400 K if its desorption activation energy were (a) 20 kJ mol−1 , (b) 200 kJ mol−1 ? Take τ0 = 0.12 ps. For how long on average would the same atoms remain at 800 K? 25.11a A solid in contact with a gas at 12 kPa and 25°C adsorbs 2.5 mg of the gas and obeys the Langmuir isotherm. The enthalpy change when 1.00 mmol of the adsorbed gas is desorbed is +10.2 J. What is the equilibrium pressure for the adsorption of 2.5 mg of gas at 40°C? 25.11b A solid in contact with a gas at 8.86 kPa and 25°C adsorbs 4.67 mg of the gas and obeys the Langmuir isotherm. The enthalpy change when 1.00 mmol of the adsorbed gas is desorbed is +12.2 J. What is the equilibrium pressure for the adsorption of the same mass of gas at 45°C? 25.12a Hydrogen iodide is very strongly adsorbed on gold but only slightly adsorbed on platinum. Assume the adsorption follows the Langmuir isotherm and predict the order of the HI decomposition reaction on each of the two metal surfaces. 954 25 PROCESSES AT SOLID SURFACES 25.12b Suppose it is known that ozone adsorbs on a particular surface in accord with a Langmuir isotherm. How could you use the pressure dependence of the fractional coverage to distinguish between adsorption (a) without dissociation, (b) with dissociation into O + O2, (c) with dissociation into O + O + O? 25.13a Nitrogen gas adsorbed on charcoal to the extent of 0.921 cm3 g−1 at 490 kPa and 190 K, but at 250 K the same amount of adsorption was achieved only when the pressure was increased to 3.2 MPa. What is the enthalpy of adsorption of nitrogen on charcoal? 25.13b Nitrogen gas adsorbed on a surface to the extent of 1.242 cm3 g−1 at 350 kPa and 180 K, but at 240 K the same amount of adsorption was achieved only when the pressure was increased to 1.02 MPa. What is the enthalpy of adsorption of nitrogen on the surface? 25.14a In an experiment on the adsorption of oxygen on tungsten it was found that the same volume of oxygen was desorbed in 27 min at 1856 K and 2.0 min at 1978 K. What is the activation energy of desorption? How long would it take for the same amount to desorb at (a) 298 K, (b) 3000 K? 25.14b In an experiment on the adsorption of ethene on iron it was found that the same volume of the gas was desorbed in 1856 s at 873 K and 8.44 s at 1012 K. What is the activation energy of desorption? How long would it take for the same amount of ethene to desorb at (a) 298 K, (b) 1500 K? 25.15a The Helmholtz model of the electric double layer is equivalent to a parallel plate capacitor. Hence the potential difference across the double layer is given by ∆ϕ = σd/ε, where d is the distance between the plates and σ is the surface charge density. Assuming that this model holds for concentrated salt solutions calculate the magnitude of the electric field at the surface of silica in 5.0 M NaCl(aq) if the surface charge density is 0.10 C m−2 . 25.15b Refer to the preceding exercise. Calculate the magnitude of the electric field at the surface of silica in 4.5 M NaCl(aq) if the surface charge density is 0.12 C m−2 . 25.16a The transfer coefficient of a certain electrode in contact with M3+ and M4+ in aqueous solution at 25°C is 0.39. The current density is found to be 55.0 mA cm−2 when the overvoltage is 125 mV. What is the overvoltage required for a current density of 75 mA cm−2 ? 25.16b The transfer coefficient of a certain electrode in contact with M2+ and M3+ in aqueous solution at 25°C is 0.42. The current density is found to be 17.0 mA cm−2 when the overvoltage is 105 mV. What is the overvoltage required for a current density of 72 mA cm−2 ? 25.17a Determine the exchange current density from the information given in Exercise 25.16a. 25.17b Determine the exchange current density from the information given in Exercise 25.16b. 25.18a To a first approximation, significant evolution or deposition occurs in electrolysis only if the overpotential exceeds about 0.6 V. To illustrate this criterion determine the effect that increasing the overpotential from 0.40 V to 0.60 V has on the current density in the electrolysis of 1.0 M NaOH(aq), which is 1.0 mA cm−2 at 0.4 V and 25°C. Take α = 0.5. 25.18b Determine the effect that increasing the overpotential from 0.50 V to 0.60 V has on the current density in the electrolysis of 1.0 M NaOH(aq), which is 1.22 mA cm−2 at 0.50 V and 25°C. Take α = 0.50. 25.19a Use the data in Table 25.6 for the exchange current density and transfer coefficient for the reaction 2 H+ + 2 e− → H2 on nickel at 25°C to determine what current density would be needed to obtain an overpotential of 0.20 V as calculated from (a) the Butler–Volmer equation, and (b) the Tafel equation. Is the validity of the Tafel approximation affected at higher overpotentials (of 0.4 V and more)? 25.19b Use the data in Table 25.6 for the exchange current density and transfer coefficient for the reaction Fe3+ + e− → Fe2+ on platinum at 25°C to determine what current density would be needed to obtain an overpotential of 0.30 V as calculated from (a) the Butler–Volmer equation, and (b) the Tafel equation. Is the validity of the Tafel approximation affected at higher overpotentials (of 0.4 V and more)? 25.20a Estimate the limiting current density at an electrode in which the concentration of Ag+ ions is 2.5 mmol dm−3 at 25°C. The thickness of the Nernst diffusion layer is 0.40 mm. The ionic conductivity of Ag+ at infinite dilution and 25°C is 6.19 mS m2 mol−1 . 25.20b Estimate the limiting current density at an electrode in which the concentration of Mg2+ ions is 1.5 mmol dm−3 at 25°C. The thickness of the Nernst diffusion layer is 0.32 mm. The ionic conductivity of Mg2+ at infinite dilution and 25°C is 10.60 mS m2 mol−1 . 25.21a A 0.10 M CdSO4(aq) solution is electrolysed between a cadmium cathode and a platinum anode with a current density of 1.00 mA cm−2 . The hydrogen overpotential is 0.60 V. What will be the concentration of Cd2+ ions when evolution of H2 just begins at the cathode? Assume all activity coefficients are unity. 25.21b A 0.10 M FeSO4(aq) solution is electrolysed between a magnesium cathode and a platinum anode with a current density of 1.50 mA cm−2 . The hydrogen overpotential is 0.60 V. What will be the concentration of Fe2+ ions when evolution of H2 just begins at the cathode? Assume all activity coefficients are unity. 25.22a A typical exchange current density, that for H+ discharge at platinum, is 0.79 mA cm−2 at 25°C. What is the current density at an electrode when its overpotential is (a) 10 mV, (b) 100 mV, (c) −5.0 V? Take α = 0.5. 25.22b The exchange current density for a Pt|Fe3+ ,Fe2+ electrode is 2.5 mA cm−2 . The standard potential of the electrode is +0.77 V. Calculate the current flowing through an electrode of surface area 1.0 cm2 as a function of the potential of the electrode. Take unit activity for both ions. 25.23a Suppose that the electrode potential is set at 1.00 V. The exchange current density is 6.0 × 10−4 A cm−2 and α = 0.50. Calculate the current density for the ratio of activities a(Fe3+ )/a(Fe2+ ) in the range 0.1 to 10.0 and at 25°C. 25.23b Suppose that the electrode potential is set at 0.50 V. Calculate the current density for the ratio of activities a(Cr3+ )/a(Cr2+ ) in the range 0.1 to 10.0 and at 25°C. 25.24a What overpotential is needed to sustain a current of 20 mA at a Pt|Fe3+ ,Fe2+ electrode in which both ions are at a mean activity a = 0.10? The surface area of the electrode is 1.0 cm2 . 25.24b What overpotential is needed to sustain a current of 15 mA at a Pt|Ce4+ ,Ce3+ electrode in which both ions are at a mean activity a = 0.010? 25.25a How many electrons or protons are transported through the double layer in each second when the Pt,H2|H+ , Pt|Fe3+ ,Fe2+ , and Pb,H2|H+ electrodes are at equilibrium at 25°C? Take the area as 1.0 cm2 in each case. Estimate the number of times each second a single atom on the surface takes part in a electron transfer event, assuming an electrode atom occupies about (280 pm)2 of the surface. 25.25b How many electrons or protons are transported through the double layer in each second when the Cu,H2|H+ and Pt|Ce4+ ,Ce3+ electrodes are at equilibrium at 25°C? Take the area as 1.0 cm2 in each case. Estimate the number of times each second a single atom on the surface takes part in a electron transfer event, assuming an electrode atom occupies about (260 pm)2 of the surface. 25.26a What is the effective resistance at 25°C of an electrode interface when the overpotential is small? Evaluate it for 1.0 cm2 (a) Pt,H2|H+ , (b) Hg,H2|H+ electrodes. PROBLEMS 955 25.26b Evaluate the effective resistance at 25°C of an electrode interface for 1.0 cm2 (a) Pb,H2|H+ , (b) Pt|Fe2+ ,Fe3+ electrodes. 25.27a State what happens when a platinum electrode in an aqueous solution containing both Cu2+ and Zn2+ ions at unit activity is made the cathode of an electrolysis cell. 25.27b State what happens when a platinum electrode in an aqueous solution containing both Fe2+ and Ni2+ ions at unit activity is made the cathode of an electrolysis cell. 25.28a What are the conditions that allow a metal to be deposited from aqueous acidic solution before hydrogen evolution occurs significantly at 293 K? Why may silver be deposited from aqueous silver nitrate? 25.28b The overpotential for hydrogen evolution on cadmium is about 1 V at current densities of 1 mA cm−2 . Why may cadmium be deposited from aqueous cadmium sulfate? 25.29a The exchange current density for H+ discharge at zinc is about 50 pA cm−2 . Can zinc be deposited from a unit activity aqueous solution of a zinc salt? 25.29b The standard potential of the Zn2+ |Zn electrode is −0.76 V at 25°C. The exchange current density for H+ discharge at platinum is 0.79 mA cm−2 . Can zinc be plated on to platinum at that temperature? (Take unit activities.) 25.30a Can magnesium be deposited on a zinc electrode from a unit activity acid solution at 25°C? 25.30b Can iron be deposited on a copper electrode from a unit activity acid solution at 25°C? 25.31a Calculate the maximum (zero-current) potential difference of a nickel–cadmium cell, and the maximum possible power output when 100 mA is drawn at 25°C. 25.31b Calculate the maximum (zero-current) potential difference of a lead–acid cell, and the maximum possible power output when 100 mA is drawn at 25°C. 25.32a The corrosion current density jcorr at an iron anode is 1.0 A m−2 . What is the corrosion rate in millimetres per year? Assume uniform corrosion. 25.32b The corrosion current density jcorr at a zinc anode is 2.0 A m−2 . What is the corrosion rate in millimetres per year? Assume uniform corrosion. Problems* Numerical problems 25.1 The movement of atoms and ions on a surface depends on their ability to leave one position and stick to another, and therefore on the energy changes that occur. As an illustration, consider a two-dimensional square lattice of univalent positive and negative ions separated by 200 pm, and consider a cation on the upper terrace of this array. Calculate, by direct summation, its Coulombic interaction when it is in an empty lattice point directly above an anion. Now consider a high step in the same lattice, and let the cation move into the corner formed by the step and the terrace. Calculate the Coulombic energy for this position, and decide on the likely settling point for the cation. 25.2 In a study of the catalytic properties of a titanium surface it was necessary to maintain the surface free from contamination. Calculate the collision frequency per square centimetre of surface made by O2 molecules at (a) 100 kPa, (b) 1.00 Pa and 300 K. Estimate the number of collisions made with a single surface atom in each second. The conclusions underline the importance of working at very low pressures (much lower than 1 Pa, in fact) in order to study the properties of uncontaminated surfaces. Take the nearestneighbour distance as 291 pm. 25.3 Nickel is face-centred cubic with a unit cell of side 352 pm. What is the number of atoms per square centimetre exposed on a surface formed by (a) (100), (b) (110), (c) (111) planes? Calculate the frequency of molecular collisions per surface atom in a vessel containing (a) hydrogen, (b) propane at 25°C when the pressure is (i) 100 Pa, (ii) 0.10 µTorr. 25.4 The data below are for the chemisorption of hydrogen on copper powder at 25°C. Confirm that they fit the Langmuir isotherm at low coverages. Then find the value of K for the adsorption equilibrium and the adsorption volume corresponding to complete coverage. p/Pa 25 129 253 540 1000 1593 V/cm3 0.042 0.163 0.221 0.321 0.411 0.471 25.5 The data for the adsorption of ammonia on barium fluoride are reported below. Confirm that they fit a BET isotherm and find values of c and Vmon. (a) θ = 0°C, p* = 429.6 kPa: p/kPa 14.0 37.6 65.6 79.2 82.7 100.7 106.4 V/cm3 11.1 13.5 14.9 16.0 15.5 17.3 16.5 (b) θ = 18.6°C, p* = 819.7 kPa: p/kPa 5.3 8.4 14.4 29.2 62.1 74.0 80.1 102.0 V/cm3 9.2 9.8 10.3 11.3 12.9 13.1 13.4 14.1 25.6 The following data have been obtained for the adsorption of H2 on the surface of 1.00 g of copper at 0°C. The volume of H2 below is the volume that the gas would occupy at STP (0°C and 1 atm). p/atm 0.050 0.100 0.150 0.200 0.250 V/cm3 1.22 1.33 1.31 1.36 1.40 Determine the volume of H2 necessary to form a monolayer and estimate the surface area of the copper sample. The density of liquid hydrogen is 0.708 g cm−3 . 25.7 The adsorption of solutes on solids from liquids often follows a Freundlich isotherm. Check the applicability of this isotherm to the following data for the adsorption of acetic acid on charcoal at 25°C and find the values of the parameters c1 and c2. [acid]/(mol dm−3 ) 0.05 0.10 0.50 1.0 1.5 wa/g 0.04 0.06 0.12 0.16 0.19 wa is the mass adsorbed per unit mass of charcoal. 25.8 In some catalytic reactions the products may adsorb more strongly than the reacting gas. This is the case, for instance, in the catalytic decomposition of ammonia on platinum at 1000°C. As a first step in examining the kinetics of * Problems denoted with the symbol ‡ were supplied by Charles Trapp, Carmen Giunta, and Marshall Cady. 25.14 The standard potentials of lead and tin are −126 mV and −136 mV respectively at 25°C, and the overvoltage for their deposition are close to zero. What should their relative activities be in order to ensure simultaneous deposition from a mixture? 25.15 The limiting current density for the reaction I3 − + 2 e− → 3 I− at a platinum electrode is 28.9 µA cm−2 when the concentration of KI is 6.6 × 10−4 mol dm−3 and the temperature 25°C. The diffusion coefficient of I3 − is 1.14 × 10−9 m2 s−3 . What is the thickness of the diffusion layer? 25.16 Estimating the power output and potential of a cell under operating conditions is very difficult, but eqn 25.65 summarizes, in an approximate way, some of the parameters involved. As a first step in manipulating this expression, identify all the quantities that depend on the ionic concentrations. Express E in terms of the concentration and conductivities of the ions present in the cell. Estimate the parameters for Zn(s)|ZnSO4(aq)||CuSO4(aq)|Cu(s). Take electrodes of area 5 cm2 separated by 5 cm. Ignore both potential differences and resistance of the liquid junction. Take the concentration as 1 mol dm−3 , the temperature 25°C, and neglect activity coefficients. Plot E as a function of the current drawn. On the same graph, plot the power output of the cell. What current corresponds to maximum power? 25.17 Consider a cell in which the current is activation-controlled. Show that the current for maximum power can be estimated by plotting log(I/I0) and c1 − c2I against I (where I0 = A2 j0j′0 and c1 and c2 are constants), and looking for the point of intersection of the curves. Carry through this analysis for the cell in Problem 25.16 ignoring all concentration overpotentials. 25.18‡ The rate of deposition of iron, v, on the surface of an iron electrode from an aqueous solution of Fe2+ has been studied as a function of potential, E, relative to the standard hydrogen electrode, by J. Kanya (J. Electroanal. Chem. 84, 83 (1977)). The values in the table below are based on the data obtained with an electrode of surface area 9.1 cm2 in contact with a solution of concentration 1.70 µmol dm−3 in Fe2+ . (a) Assuming unit activity coefficients, calculate the zero current potential of the Fe2+ /Fe cathode and the overpotential at each value of the working potential. (b) Calculate the cathodic current density, jc, from the rate of deposition of Fe2+ for each value of E. (c) Examine the extent to which the data fit the Tafel equation and calculate the exchange current density. v/(pmol s−1 ) 1.47 2.18 3.11 7.26 −E/mV 702 727 752 812 25.19‡ The thickness of the diffuse double layer according to the Gouy–Chapman model is given by eqn 19.46. Use this equation to calculate and plot the thickness as a function of concentration and electrolyte type at 25°C. For examples, choose aqueous solutions of NaCl and Na2SO4 ranging in concentration from 0.1 to 100 mmol dm−3 . 25.20‡ V.V. Losev and A.P. Pchel’nikov (Soviet Electrochem. 6, 34 (1970)) obtained the following current–voltage data for an indium anode relative to a standard hydrogen electrode at 293 K: −E/V 0.388 0.365 0.350 0.335 j/(A m−2 ) 0 0.590 1.438 3.507 Use these data to calculate the transfer coefficient and the exchange current density. What is the cathodic current density when the potential is 0.365 V? 25.21‡ The redox reactions of quinones have been the subject of many studies over the years and they continue to be of interest to electrochemists. In a study of methone (1,1-dimethyl-3,5-cyclohexanedione) by E. Kariv, J. Hermolin, and E. Gileadi (Electrochim. Acta 16, 1437 (1971)), the following current–voltage data were obtained for the reduction of the quinone in anhydrous butanol on a mercury electrode: −E/V 1.50 1.58 1.63 1.72 1.87 1.98 ≥2.10 j/(A m−2 ) 10 30 50 100 200 250 290 956 25 PROCESSES AT SOLID SURFACES this type of process, show that the rate of ammonia decomposition should follow = −kc in the limit of very strong adsorption of hydrogen. Start by showing that, when a gas J adsorbs very strongly, and its pressure is pJ, the fraction of uncovered sites is approximately 1/KpJ. Solve the rate equation for the catalytic decomposition of NH3 on platinum and show that a plot of F(t) = (1/t) ln(p/p0) against G(t) = (p − p0)/t, where p is the pressure of ammonia, should give a straight line from which kc can be determined. Check the rate law on the basis of the data below, and find kc for the reaction. t/s 0 30 60 100 160 200 250 p/kPa 13.3 11.7 11.2 10.7 10.3 9.9 9.6 25.9‡ A. Akgerman and M. Zardkoohi (J. Chem. Eng. Data 41, 185 (1996)) examined the adsorption of phenol from aqueous solution on to fly ash at 20°C. They fitted their observations to a Freundlich isotherm of the form cads = Kc1/n sol, where cads is the concentration of adsorbed phenol and csol is the concentration of aqueous phenol. Among the data reported are the following: csol/(mg g−1 ) 8.26 15.65 25.43 31.74 40.00 cads/(mg g−1 ) 4.4 19.2 35.2 52.0 67.2 Determine the constants K and n. What further information would be necessary in order to express the data in terms of fractional coverage, θ? 25.10‡ C. Huang and W.P. Cheng (J. Colloid Interface Sci. 188, 270 (1997)) examined the adsorption of the hexacyanoferrate(III) ion, [Fe(CN)6]3− , on γAl2O3 from aqueous solution. They modelled the adsorption with a modified Langmuir isotherm, obtaining the following values of K at pH = 6.5: T/K 283 298 308 318 10−11 K 2.642 2.078 1.286 1.085 Determine the isosteric enthalpy of adsorption, ∆adsH7 , at this pH. The researchers also reported ∆adsS7 = +146 J mol−1 K−1 under these conditions. Determine ∆adsG7 . 25.11‡ M.-G. Olivier and R. Jadot (J. Chem. Eng. Data 42, 230 (1997)) studied the adsorption of butane on silica gel. They report the following amounts of absorption (in moles per kilogram of silica gel) at 303 K: p/kPa 31.00 38.22 53.03 76.38 101.97 n/(mol kg−1 ) 1.00 1.17 1.54 2.04 2.49 p/kPa 130.47 165.06 182.41 205.75 219.91 n/(mol kg−1 ) 2.90 3.22 3.30 3.35 3.36 Fit these data to a Langmuir isotherm, and determine the value of n that corresponds to complete coverage and the constant K. 25.12‡ The following data were obtained for the extent of adsorption, s, of acetone on charcoal from an aqueous solution of molar concentration, c, at 18°C. c/(mmol dm−3 ) 15.0 23.0 42.0 84.0 165 390 800 s/(mmol acetone/g charcoal) 0.60 0.75 1.05 1.50 2.15 3.50 5.10 Which isotherm fits this data best, Langmuir, Freundlich, or Temkin? 25.13 In an experiment on the Pt|H2|H+ electrode in dilute H2SO4 the following current densities were observed at 25°C. Evaluate α and j0 for the electrode. η /mV 50 100 150 200 250 j/(mA cm−2 ) 2.66 8.91 29.9 100 335 How would the current density at this electrode depend on the overpotential of the same set of magnitudes but of opposite sign? pNH3 pH2 dpNH3 dt PROBLEMS 957 (a) How well do these data fit the empirical Tafel equation? (b) The authors postulate that the reduction product is the dimer HMMH formed by the following mechanism (where the quinone is denoted M): (1) M(sol) 5 M(ads) (2) M(ads) + H+ + e− → MH(ads) (3) MH(ads) + MH(ads) 5 HMMH The affixes sol and ads refer to species in solution and on the surface of the electrode, respectively. Does this mechanism help to explain the current–voltage data? 25.22‡ An early study of the hydrogen overpotential is that of H. Bowden and T. Rideal (Proc. Roy. Soc. A120, 59 (1928)), who measured the overpotential for H2 evolution with a mercury electrode in dilute aqueous solutions of H2SO4 at 25°C. Determine the exchange current density and transfer coefficient, α, from their data: j/(mA m−2 ) 2.9 6.3 28 100 250 630 1650 3300 η/V 0.60 0.65 0.73 0.79 0.84 0.89 0.93 0.96 Explain any deviations from the result expected from the Tafel equation. Theoretical problems 25.23 Although the attractive van der Waals interaction between individual molecules varies as R−6 , the interaction of a molecule with a nearby solid (a homogeneous collection of molecules) varies as R−3 , where R is its vertical distance above the surface. Confirm this assertion. Calculate the interaction energy between an Ar atom and the surface of solid argon on the basis of a Lennard-Jones (6,12)-potential. Estimate the equilibrium distance of an atom above the surface. 25.24 Use the Gibbs adsorption isotherm (another name for eqn 19.50), to show that the volume adsorbed per unit area of solid, Va/σ, is related to the pressure of the gas by Va = −(σ/RT)(dµ/d ln p), where µ is the chemical potential of the adsorbed gas. 25.25 If the dependence of the chemical potential of the gas on the extent of surface coverage is known, the Gibbs adsorption isotherm, eqn 19.50, can be integrated to give a relation between Va and p, as in a normal adsorption isotherm. For instance, suppose that the change in the chemical potential of a gas when it adsorbs is of the form dµ = −c2(RT/σ)dVa, where c2 is a constant of proportionality: show that the Gibbs isotherm leads to the Freundlich isotherm in this case. 25.26 Finally we come full circle and return to the Langmuir isotherm. Find the form of dµ that, when inserted in the Gibbs adsorption isotherm, leads to the Langmuir isotherm. 25.27 Show that, for the association part of the surface plasmon resonance experiment in Fig. 25.27, R(t) = Req(1 − e−kobst) and write an expression for kobs. Then, derive an expression for R(t) that applies to the dissociation part of the surface plasmon resonance experiment in Fig. 25.27. 25.28 If α = 1 –2, an electrode interface is unable to rectify alternating current because the current density curve is symmetrical about η = 0. When α ≠ 1 –2, the magnitude of the current density depends on the sign of the overpotential, and so some degree of ‘faradaic rectification’ may be obtained. Suppose that the overpotential varies as η = η0 cos ωt. Derive an expression for the mean flow of current (averaged over a cycle) for general α, and confirm that the mean current is zero when α = 1 –2. In each case work in the limit of small η0 but to second order in η0F/RT. Calculate the mean direct current at 25°C for a 1.0 cm2 hydrogen–platinum electrode with α = 0.38 when the overpotential varies between ±10 mV at 50 Hz. 25.29 Now suppose that the overpotential is in the high overpotential region at all times even though it is oscillating. What waveform will the current across the interface show if it varies linearly and periodically (as a sawtooth waveform) between η− and η+ around η0? Take α = 1 –2. 25.30 Derive an expression for the current density at an electrode where the rate process is diffusion-controlled and ηc is known. Sketch the form of j/jL as a function of ηc. What changes occur if anion currents are involved? Applications: to chemical engineering and environmental science 25.31 The designers of a new industrial plant wanted to use a catalyst codenamed CR-1 in a step involving the fluorination of butadiene. As a first step in the investigation they determined the form of the adsorption isotherm. The volume of butadiene adsorbed per gram of CR-1 at 15°C varied with pressure as given below. Is the Langmuir isotherm suitable at this pressure? p/kPa 13.3 26.7 40.0 53.3 66.7 80.0 V/cm3 17.9 33.0 47.0 60.8 75.3 91.3 Investigate whether the BET isotherm gives a better description of the adsorption of butadiene on CR-1. At 15°C, p*( butadiene) = 200 kPa. Find Vmon and c. 25.32‡ In a study relevant to automobile catalytic converters, C.E. Wartnaby, A. Stuck, Y.Y. Yeo, and D.A. King (J. Phys. Chem. 100, 12483 (1996)) measured the enthalpy of adsorption of CO, NO, and O2 on initially clean platinum 110 surfaces. They report ∆adsH7 for NO to be −160 kJ mol−1 . How much more strongly adsorbed is NO at 500°C than at 400°C? 25.33‡ The removal or recovery of volatile organic compounds (VOCs) from exhaust gas streams is an important process in environmental engineering. Activated carbon has long been used as an adsorbent in this process, but the presence of moisture in the stream reduces its effectiveness. M.-S. Chou and J.-H. Chiou (J. Envir. Engrg. ASCE, 123, 437(1997)) have studied the effect of moisture content on the adsorption capacities of granular activated carbon (GAC) for normal hexane and cyclohexane in air streams. From their data for dry streams containing cyclohexane, shown in the table below, they conclude that GAC obeys a Langmuir type model in which qVOC,RH=0 = abcVOC/(1 + bcVOC), where q = mVOC/mGAC, RH denotes relative humidity, a the maximum adsorption capacity, b is an affinity parameter, and c is the abundance in parts per million (ppm). The following table gives values of qVOC,RH=0 for cyclohexane: c/ppm 33.6°C 41.5°C 57.4°C 76.4°C 99°C 200 0.080 0.069 0.052 0.042 0.027 500 0.093 0.083 0.072 0.056 0.042 1000 0.101 0.088 0.076 0.063 0.045 2000 0.105 0.092 0.083 0.068 0.052 3000 0.112 0.102 0.087 0.072 0.058 (a) By linear regression of 1/qVOC, RH=0 against 1/cVOC, test the goodness of fit and determine values of a and b. (b) The parameters a and b can be related to ∆adsH, the enthalpy of adsorption, and ∆bH, the difference in activation energy for adsorption and desorption of the VOC molecules, through Arrhenius type equations of the form a = kaexp(−∆adsH/RT) and b = kbexp(−∆bH/RT). Test the goodness of fit of the data to these equations and obtain values for ka, kb, ∆adsH, and ∆bH. (c) What interpretation might you give to ka and kb? 25.34‡ M.-S. Chou and J.-H. Chiou (J. Envir. Engrg., ASCE, 123, 437(1997)) have studied the effect of moisture content on the adsorption capacities of granular activated carbon (GAC, Norit PK 1–3) for the volatile organic compounds (VOCs) normal hexane and cyclohexane in air streams. The following table shows the adsorption capacities (qwater = mwater/mGAC) of GAC for pure water from moist air streams as a function of relative humidity (RH) in the absence of VOCs at 41.5°C. RH 0.00 0.26 0.49 0.57 0.80 1.00 qwater 0.00 0.026 0.072 0.091 0.161 0.229 958 25 PROCESSES AT SOLID SURFACES The authors conclude that the data at this and other temperatures obey a Freundlich type isotherm, qwater = k(RH)1/n . (a) Test this hypothesis for their data at 41.5°C and determine the constants k and n. (b) Why might VOCs obey the Langmuir model, but water the Freundlich model? (c) When both water vapour and cyclohexane were present in the stream the values given in the table below were determined for the ratio rVOC = qVOC/qVOC, RH=0 at 41.5°C. RH 0.00 0.10 0.25 0.40 0.53 0.76 0.81 rVOC 1.00 0.98 0.91 0.84 0.79 0.67 0.61 The authors propose that these data fit the equation rVOC = 1 − qwater. Test their proposal and determine values for k and n and compare to those obtained in part (b) for pure water. Suggest reasons for any differences. 25.35‡ The release of petroleum products by leaky underground storage tanks is a serious threat to clean ground water. BTEX compounds (benzene, toluene, ethylbenzene, and xylenes) are of primary concern due to their ability to cause health problems at low concentrations. D.S. Kershaw, B.C. Kulik, and S. Pamukcu (J. Geotech. & Geoenvir. Engrg. 123, 324(1997)) have studied the ability of ground tyre rubber to sorb (adsorb and absorb) benzene and oxylene. Though sorption involves more than surface interactions, sorption data are usually found to fit one of the adsorption isotherms. In this study, the authors have tested how well their data fit the linear (q = Kceq), Freundlich (q = KFc1/n eq ), and Langmuir (q = KLMceq/(1 + KLceq) type isotherms, where q is the mass of solvent sorbed per gram of ground rubber (in milligrams per gram), the Ks and M are empirical constants, and ceq the equilibrium concentration of contaminant in solution (in milligrams per litre). (a) Determine the units of the empirical constants. (b) Determine which of the isotherms best fits the data in the table below for the sorption of benzene on ground rubber. ceq/(mg dm−3 ) 97.10 36.10 10.40 6.51 6.21 2.48 q/(mg g−1 ) 7.13 4.60 1.80 1.10 0.55 0.31 (c) Compare the sorption efficiency of ground rubber to that of granulated activated charcoal, which for benzene has been shown to obey the Freundlich isotherm in the form q = 1.0c1.6 eq with coefficient of determination R2 = 0.94. 25.36 Calculate the thermodynamic limit to the zero-current potential of fuel cells operating on (a) hydrogen and oxygen, (b) methane and air, and (c) propane and air. Use the Gibbs energy information in the Data section, and take the species to be in their standard states at 25°C. 25.37 For each group below, determine which metal has a thermodynamic tendency to corrode in moist air at pH = 7. Take as a criterion of corrosion a metal ion concentration of at least 10−6 mol dm−3 . (a) Fe, Cu, Pb, Al, Ag, Cr, Co (b) Ni, Cd, Mg, Ti, Mn 25.38 Estimate the magnitude of the corrosion current for a patch of zinc of area 0.25 cm2 in contact with a similar area of iron in an aqueous environment at 25°C. Take the exchange current densities as 1 µA cm−2 and the local ion concentrations as 1 µmol dm−3 . 25.39 The corrosion potential of iron immersed in a de-aerated acidic solution of pH = 3 is −0.720 V as measured at 25°C relative to the standard calomel electrode with potential 0.2802 V. A Tafel plot of cathodic current density against overpotential yields a slope of 18 V−1 and the hydrogen ion exchange current density j0 = 0.10 µA cm−2 . Calculate the corrosion rate in milligrams of iron per square centimetre per day (mg cm−2 d−1 ). Appendix 1 Quantities, units, and notational conventions The result of a measurement is a physical quantity (such as mass or density) that is reported as a numerical multiple of an agreed unit: physical quantity = numerical value × unit For example, the mass of an object may be reported as m = 2.5 kg and its density as d = 1.010 kg dm−3 where the units are, respectively, 1 kilogram (1 kg) and 1 kilogram per decimetre cubed (1 kg dm−3 ). Units are treated like algebraic quantities, and may be multiplied, divided, and cancelled. Thus, the expression (physical quantity)/unit is simply the numerical value of the measurement in the specified units, and hence is a dimensionless quantity. For instance, the mass reported above could be denoted m/kg = 2.5 and the density as d/(kg dm−3 ) = 1.01. Physical quantities are denoted by italic or (sloping) Greek letters (as in m for mass and Π for osmotic pressure). Units are denoted by Roman letters (as in m for metre). Names of quantities A substance is a distinct, pure form of matter. The amount of substance, n (more colloquially ‘number of moles’ or ‘chemical amount’), in a sample is reported in terms of the mole (mol): 1 mol is the amount of substance that contains as many objects (atoms, molecules, ions, or other specified entities) as there are atoms in exactly 12 g of carbon-12. This number is found experimentally to be approximately 6.02 × 1023 (see the endpapers for more precise values). If a sample contains N entities, the amount of substance it contains is n = N/NA, where NA is the Avogadro constant: NA = 6.02 × 1023 mol−1 . Note that NA is a quantity with units, not a pure number. An extensivepropertyis a property that depends on the amount of substance in the sample. Two examples are mass and volume. An intensive property is a property that is independent of the amount of substance in the sample. Examples are temperature, mass density (mass divided by volume), and pressure. A molarproperty, Xm, is the value of an extensive property, X, of the sample divided by the amount of substance present in the sample: Xm = X/n. A molar property is intensive. An example is the molarvolume, Vm, the volume of a sample divided by the amount of substance in the sample (the volume per mole). The one exception to the notation Xm is the molar mass, which is denoted M. The molar mass of an element is the mass per mole of its atoms. The molar mass of a molecular compound is the A1 Names of quantities Units Notational conventions Further reading 960 Appendix 1 QUANTITIES, UNITS, AND NOTATIONAL CONVENTIONS mass per mole of molecules, and the molar mass of an ionic compound is the mass per mole of formula units. A formula unit of an ionic compound is an assembly of ions corresponding to the chemical formula of the compound; so the formula unit NaCl consists of one Na+ ion and one Cl− ion. The names atomic weight and molecular weight are still widely used in place of molar mass (often with the units omitted), but we shall not use them in this text. The molar concentration (‘molarity’) of a solute in a solution is the amount ofsubstance of the solute divided by the volume of the solution. Molar concentration is usually expressed in moles per decimetre cubed (mol dm−3 or mol L−1 ; 1 dm3 is identical to 1 L). A solution in which the molar concentration of the solute is 1 mol dm−3 is prepared by dissolving 1 mol of the solute in sufficient solvent to prepare 1 dm3 of solution. Such a solution is widely called a ‘1 molar’ solution and denoted 1 m. The term molality refers to the amount of substance of solute divided by the mass of solvent used to prepare the solution. Its units are typically moles of solute per kilogram of solvent (mol kg−1 ). Units In the International System of units (SI, from the French Système International d’Unités), the units are formed from seven base units listed in Table A1.1. All other physical quantities may be expressed as combinations of these physical quantities and reported in terms of derived units. Thus, volume is (length)3 and may be reported as a multiple of 1 metre cubed (1 m3 ), and density, which is mass/volume, may be reported as a multiple of 1 kilogram per metre cubed (1 kg m−3 ). A number of derived units have special names and symbols. The names of units derived from names of people are lower case (as in torr, joule, pascal, and kelvin), but their symbols are upper case (as in Torr, J, Pa, and K). Among the most important for our purposes are those listed in Table A1.2. In all cases (both for base and derived quantities), the units may be modified by a prefix that denotes a factor of a power of 10. In a perfect world, Greek prefixes of units are upright (as in µm) and sloping for physical properties (as in µ for chemical potential), but available typefaces are not always so obliging. Among the most common prefixes are those listed in Table A1.3. Examples of the use of these prefixes are 1 nm = 10−9 m 1 ps = 10−12 s 1 µmol = 10−6 mol Table A1.1 The SI base units Physical quantity Symbol for quantity Base unit Length l metre, m Mass M kilogram, kg Time t second, s Electric current I ampere, A Thermodynamic temperature T kelvin, K Amount of substance n mole, mol Luminous intensity I candela, cd UNITS 961 The kilogram (kg) is anomalous: although it is a base unit, it is interpreted as 103 g, and prefixes are attached to the gram (as in 1 mg = 10−3 g). Powers of units apply to the prefix as well as the unit they modify: 1 cm3 = 1 (cm)3 = 1 (10−2 m)3 = 10−6 m3 Note that 1 cm3 does not mean 1 c(m3 ). When carrying out numerical calculations, it is usually safest to write out the numerical value of an observable as powers of 10. There are a number of units that are in wide use but are not a part of the International System. Some are exactly equal to multiples of SI units. These include the litre (L), which is exactly 103 cm3 (or 1 dm3 ) and the atmosphere (atm), which is exactly 101.325 kPa. Others rely on the values of fundamental constants, and hence are liable to change when the values of the fundamental constants are modified by more accurate or more precise measurements. Thus, the size of the energy unit electronvolt (eV), the energy acquired by an electron that is accelerated through a potential difference of exactly 1 V, depends on the value of the charge of the electron, and the present (2005) conversion factor is 1 eV = 1.602 177 33 × 10−19 J. Table A1.4 gives the conversion factors for a number of these convenient units. Notational conventions We use SI units and IUPAC conventions throughout (see Further reading), except in a small number of cases. The default numbering of equations is (C.n), where C is the chapter; however, [C.n] is used to denote a definition and {C.n} is used to indicate that a variable x should be interpreted as x/x7 , where x7 is a standard value. A subscript r Table A1.3 Common SI prefixes Prefix z a f p n _ m c d Name zepto atto femto pico nano micro milli centi deci Factor 10−21 10−18 10−15 10−12 10−9 10−6 10−3 10−2 10−1 Prefix k M G T Name kilo mega giga tera Factor 103 106 109 1012 Table A1.2 A selection of derived units Physical quantity Derived unit* Name of derived unt Force 1 kg m s−2 newton, N Pressure 1 kg m−1 s−2 pascal, Pa 1 N m−2 Energy 1 kg m2 s−2 joule, J 1 N m 1 Pa m3 Power kg m2 s−3 watt, W 1 J s−1 * Equivalent definitions in terms of derived units are given following the definition in terms of base units. 962 Appendix 1 QUANTITIES, UNITS, AND NOTATIONAL CONVENTIONS attached to an equation number indicates that the equation is valid only for a reversible change. A superscript ° indicates that the equation is valid for an ideal system, such as a perfect gas or an ideal solution. We use p7 = 1 bar b7 = 1 mol kg−1 1 c7 = 1 mol dm−3 When referring to temperature, T denotes a thermodynamic temperature (for instance, on the Kelvin scale) and θ a temperature on the Celsius scale. For numerical calculations, we take special care to use the proper number of significant figures. Unless otherwise specified, assume that zeros in data like 10, 100, 1000, etc are significant (that is, interpret such data as 10., 100., 100., etc). Further reading I.M. Mills (ed.), Quantities, units, and symbols in physical chemistry. Blackwell Scientific, Oxford (1993). Table A1.4 Some common units Physical quantity Name of unit Symbol for unit Value* Time minute min 60 s hour h 3600 s day d 86 400 s Length ångström Å 10−10 m Volume litre L, l 1 dm3 Mass tonne t 103 kg Pressure bar bar 105 Pa atmosphere atm 101.325 kPa Energy electronvolt eV 1.602 177 33 × 10−19 J 96.485 31 kJ mol−1 * All values in the final column are exact, except for the definition of 1 eV, which depends on the measured value of e. Appendix 2 Mathematical techniques Basic procedures A2.1 Logarithms and exponentials The natural logarithm of a number x is denoted ln x, and is defined as the power to which e = 2.718 . . . must be raised for the result to be equal to x. It follows from the definition of logarithms that ln x + ln y + · · · = ln xy · · · (A2.1) ln x − ln y = ln(x/y) (A2.2) a ln x = ln xa (A2.3) We also encounter the common logarithm of a number, log x, the logarithm compiled with 10 in place of e. Common logarithms follow the same rules of addition and subtraction as natural logarithms. Common and natural logarithms are related by ln x = ln 10 log x ≈ 2.303 log x (A2.4) The exponential function, ex , plays a very special role in the mathematics of chemistry. The following properties are important: ex ey ez . . . . = ex+y+z+ · · · (A2.5) ex /ey = ex−y (A2.6) (ex )a = eax (A2.7) A2.2 Complex numbers and complex functions Complex numbers have the form z = x + iy (A2.8) where i = (−1)1/2 . The real numbers x and y are, respectively, the real and imaginary parts of z, denoted Re(z) and Im(z). We write the complex conjugate of z, denoted z*, by replacing i by −i: z* = x − iy (A2.9) The absolutevalueor modulus of the complex number z is denoted |z| and is given by: |z| = (z*z)1/2 = (x2 + y2 )1/2 (A2.10) The following rules apply for arithmetic operations involving complex numbers: 1 Addition. If z = x + iy and z′ = x′ + iy′, then z ± z′ = (x ± x′) + i(y ± y′) (A2.11) A2 Basic procedures A2.1 Logarithms and exponentials A2.2 Complex numbers and complex functions A2.3 Vectors Calculus A2.4 Differentiation and integration A2.5 Power series and Taylor expansions A2.6 Partial derivatives A2.7 Functionals and functional derivatives A2.8 Undetermined multipliers A2.9 Differential equations Statistics and probability A2.10 Random selections A2.11 Some results of probability theory Matrix algebra A2.12 Matrix addition and multiplication A2.13 Simultaneous equations A2.14 Eigenvalue equations Further reading 964 Appendix 2 MATHEMATICAL TECHNIQUES 2 Multiplication. For z and z′ defined above, z × z′ = (x + iy)(x′ + iy′) = (xx′ − yy′) + i(xy′ + yx′) (A2.12) 3 Division. For z and z′ defined above, = (A2.13) Functions of complex arguments are useful in the discussion of wave equations (Chapter 8). We write the complex conjugate, f *, of a complex function, f, by replacing i wherever it occurs by −i. For instance, the complex conjugate of eix is e−ix . Complex exponential functions may be written in terms of trigonometric functions. For example, e±ix = cos x ± i sin x (A2.14) which implies that cos x = 1 –2(eix + e−ix ) (A2.15) sin x = − 1 –2i(eix − e−ix ) (A2.16) A2.3 Vectors A vector quantity has both magnitude and direction. The vector shown in Fig. A2.1 has components on the x, y, and z axes with magnitudes vx, vy, and vz, respectively. The vector may be represented as V = vxi + vyj + vzk (A2.17) where i, j, and k are unit vectors, vectors of magnitude 1, pointing along the positive directions on the x, y, and z axes. The magnitude of the vector is denoted v or |V| and is given by v = (v2 x + v2 y + v2 z)1/2 (A2.18) Using this representation, we can define the following vector operations: 1 Addition and subtraction. If V = vxi + vyj + vzk and u = uxi + uyj + uzk, then V ± u = (vx ± ux)i + (vy ± uy)j + (vz ± uz)k (A2.19) A graphical method for adding and subtracting vectors is sometimes desirable, as we saw in Chapters 10 and 18. Consider two vectors V and u making an angle θ (Fig. A2.2a). The first step in the addition of u to V consists of joining the tail of u to the head of V, as shown in Fig. A2.2b. In the second step, we draw a vector Vres, the resultant vector, originating from the tail of V to the head of u, as shown in Fig. A2.2c. Reversing the order of addition leads to the same result. That is, we obtain the same Vres whether we add u to V (Fig. 2.2c) or V to u (Fig. 2.3). To calculate the magnitude of Vres, we note that V, u, and Vres form a triangle and that we know the magnitudes of two of its sides (v and u) and of the angle between them (180° − θ; see Fig. A2.2c). To calculate the magnitude of the third side, vres, we make use of the law of cosines, which states that: For a triangle with sides a, b, and c, and angle C facing side c: c2 = a2 + b2 − 2ab cos C This law is summarized graphically in Fig. A2.4 and its application to the case shown in Fig. A2.2c leads to the expression z(z′)* |z′|2 z z′ vx vy vz v Fig. A2.1 The vector V has components vx, vy, and vz on the x, y, and z axes with magnitudes vx, vy, and vz, respectively. (a) (b) (c) u v qq 180°- q v v u u u v+ q Fig. A2.2 (a) The vectors V and u make an angle θ. (b) To add u to V, we first join the tail of u to the head of V, making sure that the angle θ between the vectors remains unchanged. (c) To finish the process, we draw the resultant vector by joining the tail of u to the head of V. v u+ u v Fig. A2.3 The result of adding the vector V to the vector u, with both vectors defined in Fig. A2.2a. Comparison with the result shown in Fig. A2.2c for the addition of u to V shows that reversing the order of vector addition does not affect the result. A2.4 DIFFERENTIATION AND INTEGRATION 965 v2 res = v2 + u2 − 2vu cos (180° − θ) Because cos (180° − θ) = −cos θ, it follows after taking the square-root of both sides of the preceding expression that vres = (v2 + u2 + 2vu cos θ)1/2 (A2.20) The subtraction of vectors follows the same principles outlined above for addition. Consider again the vectors shown in Fig. A2.2a. We note that subtraction of u from V amounts to addition of −u to V. It follows that in the first step of subtraction we draw −u by reversing the direction of u (Fig. A2.5a) Then, the second step consists of adding the −u to V by using the strategy shown in Fig. A2.2c: we draw a resultant vector Vres by joining the tail of −u to the head of V. 2 Multiplication. There are two ways to multiply vectors. In one procedure, the cross-product of two vectors u and V is a vector defined as u × V = (uv sin θ)l (A2.21a) where θ is the angle between the two vectors and l is a unit vector perpendicular to both u and V, with a direction determined as in Fig. A2.6. An equivalent definition is u × V = = (uyvz − uzvy)i − (uxvz − uzvx)j + (uxvy − uyvx)k (A2.21b) where the structure in the middle is a determinant (see below). The second type of vector multiplication is the scalar product (or dot product) of two vectors u and V: u · V = uv cos θ (A2.22) As its name suggests, the scalar product of two vectors is a scalar. Calculus A2.4 Differentiation and integration Rates of change of functions—slopes of their graphs—are best discussed in terms of the infinitesimal calculus. The slope of a function, like the slope of a hill, is obtained by dividing the rise of the hill by the horizontal distance (Fig. A2.7). However, because i j k u u ux y z x y zv v v a b C c a b ab C( 2 cos )= + -2 2 1/2 Fig. A2.4 The graphical representation of the law of cosines. (a) (b) v q -u v -u v uFig. A2.5 The graphical method for subtraction of the vector u from the vector V (as shown in Fig. A2.2a) consists of two steps: (a) reversing the direction of u to form −u, and (b) adding −u to V. u x y z v u vx q x y z (a) (b) uv sin u v q uv sin v ux q q Fig. A2.6 The direction of the crossproducts of two vectors u and V with an angle θ between them: (a) u × V and (b) V × u. Note that the cross-product, and the unit vector l of eqn A2.21, are perpendicular to both u and V but the direction depends on the order in which the product is taken. f x x( )+ d f x( ) x x x+ d Fig. A2.7 The slope of f(x) at x, df/dx, is obtained by making a series of approximations to the value of f(x + δx) − f(x) divided by the change in x, denoted δx, and allowing δx to approach 0 (as indicated by the vertical lines getting closer to x. 966 Appendix 2 MATHEMATICAL TECHNIQUES the slope may vary from point to point, we should make the horizontal distance between the points as small as possible. In fact, we let it become infinitesimally small —hence the name infinitesimal calculus. The values of a function f at two locations x and x + δx are f(x) and f(x + δx), respectively. Therefore, the slope of the function f at x is the vertical distance, which we write δf, divided by the horizontal distance, which we write δx: Slope = = = (A2.23) The slope at x itself is obtained by letting the horizontal distance become zero, which we write lim δx → 0. In this limit, the δ is replaced by a d, and we write Slope at x = = lim δx→0 (A2.24) To work out the slope of any function, we work out the expression on the right: this process is called differentiation and the expression for df/dx is the derivative of the function f with respect to the variable x. Some important derivatives are given inside the front cover of the text. Most of the functions encountered in chemistry can be differentiated by using the following rules (noting that in these expressions, derivatives df/dx are written as df): Rule 1 For two functions f and g: d(f + g) = df + dg (A2.25) Rule 2 (the product rule) For two functions f and g: d(fg) = f dg + g df (A2.26) Rule 3 (the quotient rule) For two functions f and g: d = df − dg (A2.27) Rule 4 (the chain rule) For a function f = f(g), where g = g(t), = (A2.28) The area under a graph of any function f is found by the techniques of integration. For instance, the area under the graph of the function f drawn in Fig. A2.8 can be written as the value of f evaluated at a point multiplied by the width of the region, δx, and then all those products f(x)δx summed over all the regions: Area between a and b = ∑f(x)δx When we allow δx to become infinitesimally small, written dx, and sum an infinite number of strips, we write: Area between a and b = Ύ b a f(x)dx (A2.29) The elongated S symbol on the right is called the integralof the function f. When written as ∫ alone, it is the indefinite integral of the function. When written with limits (as in eqn A2.29), it is the definite integral of the function. The definite integral is the indefinite integral evaluated at the upper limit (b) minus the indefinite integral evaluated at the lower limit (a). The average value of a function f(x) in the range x = a to x = b is dg dt df dg df dt f g2 1 g f g f(x + δx) − f(x) δx df dx f(x + δx) − f(x) δx δf δx rise in value horizontal distance f x( ) xa b dx Fig. A2.8 The shaded area is equal to the definite integral of f(x) between the limits a and b. A2.5 POWER SERIES AND TAYLOR EXPANSIONS 967 Average value of f(x) from a to b = Ύ b a f(x)dx (A2.30) The mean value theorem states that a continuous function has its mean value at least once in the range. Integration is the inverse of differentiation. That is, if we integrate a function and then differentiate the result, we get back the original function. Some important integrals are given on the front back cover of the text. Many other standard forms are found in tables (see Further reading) and it is also possible to calculate definite and indefinite integrals with mathematical software. Two integration techniques are useful: Technique 1 (integration by parts) For two functions f and g: Ύf dx = fg − Ύg dx (A2.31) Technique 2 (method of partial fractions) To solve an integral of the form Ύ dx, where a and b are constants, we write = − and integrate the expression on the right. It follows that Ύ = Ύ − Ύ = ln − ln + constant (A2.32) A2.5 Power series and Taylor expansions A power series has the form c0 + c1(x − a) + c2(x − a)2 + · · · + cn(x − a)n + · · · = ∞ ∑ n=0 cn(x − a)n (A2.33) where cn and a are constants. It is often useful to express a function f(x) in the vicinity of x = a as a special power series called the Taylor series, or Taylor expansion, which has the form: f(x) = f(a) + (x − a) + a (x − a)2 + · · · + a (x − a)n = ∞ ∑ n=0 a (x − a)n (A2.34) where n! denotes a factorial, given by n! = n(n − 1)(n − 2) . . . 1 (A2.35) By definition 0! = 1. The following Taylor expansions are often useful: = 1 − x + x2 + · · · ex = 1 + x + 1 –2x2 + · · · ln x = (x − 1) − 1 –2(x − 1)2 + 1 –3(x − 1)3 − 1 –4(x − 1)4 + · · · ln(1 + x) = x − 1 –2x2 + 1 –3x3 − · · · If x << 1, then (1 + x)−1 ≈ 1 − x, ex ≈ 1 + x, and ln(1 + x) ≈ x. 1 1 + x D F dn f dxn A C 1 n! D F dn f dxn A C 1 n! D F d2 f dx2 A C 1 2! D F df dx A C D F 1 b − x 1 a − x A C 1 b − a J K L dx b − x dx a − x G H I 1 b − a dx (a − x)(b − x) D F 1 b − x 1 a − x A C 1 b − a 1 (a − x)(b − x) 1 (a − x)(b − x) df dx dg dx 1 b − a 968 Appendix 2 MATHEMATICAL TECHNIQUES A2.6 Partial derivatives A partialderivativeof a function of more than one variable, such as f(x,y), is the slope of the function with respect to one of the variables, all the other variables being held constant (see Fig. 2.21). Although a partial derivative shows how a function changes when one variable changes, it may be used to determine how the function changes when more than one variable changes by an infinitesimal amount. Thus, if f is a function of x and y, then when x and y change by dx and dy, respectively, f changes by df = y dx + x dy (A2.36) where the symbol ∂ is used (instead of d) to denote a partial derivative. The quantity df is also called the differential of f. For example, if f = ax3 y + by2 , then y = 3ax2 y x = ax3 + 2by Then, when x and y undergo infinitesimal changes, f changes by df = 3ax2 ydx + (ax3 + 2by)dy Partial derivatives may be taken in any order: = (A2.37) For the function f given above, it is easy to verify that y x = 3ax2 x y = 3ax2 In the following, z is a variable on which x and y depend (for example, x, y, and z might correspond to p, V, and T). Relation 1 When x is changed at constant z: z = y + x z (A2.38) Relation 2 z = (A2.39) Relation 3 z = − y x (A2.40) By combining this relation and Relation 2 we obtain the Euler chain relation: z y x = −1 (A2.41) Relation 4 This relation establishes whether or not df is an exact differential. df = g(x,y)dx + h(x,y)dy is exact if x = y (A2.42) If df is exact, its integral between specified limits is independent of the path. D F ∂h ∂x A C D F ∂g ∂y A C D F ∂z ∂y A C D F ∂x ∂z A C D F ∂y ∂x A C D F ∂z ∂y A C D F ∂x ∂z A C D F ∂x ∂y A C 1 (∂x/∂y)z D F ∂y ∂x A C D F ∂y ∂x A C D F ∂f ∂y A C D F ∂f ∂x A C D F ∂f ∂x A C D E F D F ∂f ∂y A C ∂ ∂x A B C D E F D F ∂f ∂x A C ∂ ∂y A B C ∂2 f ∂y∂x ∂2 f ∂x∂y D F ∂f ∂y A C D F ∂f ∂x A C D F ∂f ∂y A C D F ∂f ∂x A C A2.8 UNDETERMINED MULTIPLIERS 969 A2.7 Functionals and functional derivatives Just as a function f can be regarded as a set of mathematical procedures that associates a number f(x) to a specified value of a variable x, so a functionalG gives a prescription for associating a number G[f] to a function f(x) over a specified range of the variable x. That is, the functional is a function of a function. Functionals are important in quantum chemistry. We saw in Chapter 11 that the energy of a molecule is a functional of the electron density, which in turn is a function of the position. To make the following discussion more concrete, consider the functional G[f] = Ύ 1 0 f(x)2 dx (A2.43) If we let f(x) = x, then G[f] = 1 –3 over the range 0 ≤ x ≤ 1. However, if f(x) = sin πx, then G[f] = 1 –2 over the range 0 ≤ x ≤ 1. Just as the derivative of a function f(x) tells us how the function changes with small changes δx in the variable x, so a functional derivative tells us about the variation δG of a functional G[f] with small changes δf in the function f(x). By analogy with eqn A2.24, we can write the following definition of the functional derivative as = lim δf→0 (A2.44) However, this equation does not give us a simple method for calculating the functional derivative. It can be shown that an alternative definition of δG/δf is (see Further reading): G[f + δf] − G[f] = Ύ b a δf(x) dx (A2.45) where the integral is evaluated in the range over which x varies. To see how eqn A2.45 is used to calculate a functional derivative, consider the functional given by eqn A2.43. We begin by writing G[ f + δf ] = Ύ 1 0 {f(x) + δf(x)}2 dx = Ύ 1 0 {f(x)2 + 2f(x)δf(x) + δf(x)2 }dx = Ύ 1 0 {f(x)2 + 2f(x)δf(x)}dx = G[f] + Ύ 1 0 2f(x)δf(x)dx where we have ignored the minute contribution from δf2 to arrive at the penultimate expression and then used eqn A2.43 to write the final expression. It follows that G[f + δf] − G[f] = Ύ 1 0 2f(x)δf(x)dx By comparing this expression with eqn A2.45, we see that the functional derivative is = 2f(x) A2.8 Undetermined multipliers Suppose we need to find the maximum (or minimum) value of some function f that depends on several variables x1, x2, . . . , xn. When the variables undergo a small change from xi to xi + δxi the function changes from f to f + δf, where δG δf D F δG δf A C G[f + δf] − G[f] δf δG δf 970 Appendix 2 MATHEMATICAL TECHNIQUES δf = n ∑ i δxi (A2.46) At a minimum or maximum, δf = 0, so then n ∑ i δxi = 0 (A2.47) If the xi were all independent, all the δxi would be arbitrary, and this equation could be solved by setting each (∂f/∂xi) = 0 individually. When the xi are not all independent, the δxi are not all independent, and the simple solution is no longer valid. We proceed as follows. Let the constraint connecting the variables be an equation of the form g = 0. For example, in Chapter 16, one constraint was n0 + n1 + · · · = N, which can be written g = 0, with g = (n0 + n1 + · · ·) − N The constraint g = 0 is always valid, so g remains unchanged when the xi are varied: δg = ∑ i δxi = 0 (A2.48) Because δg is zero, we can multiply it by a parameter, λ, and add it to eqn A2.47: n ∑ i + λ δxi = 0 (A2.49) This equation can be solved for one of the δx, δxn for instance, in terms of all the other δxi. All those other δxi (i = 1, 2, . . . n − 1) are independent, because there is only one constraint on the system. But here is the trick: λ is arbitrary; therefore we can choose it so that the coefficient of δxn in eqn A2.49 is zero. That is, we choose λ so that + λ = 0 (A2.50) Then eqn A2.49 becomes n−1 ∑ i + λ δxi = 0 (A2.51) Now the n − 1 variations δxi are independent, so the solution of this equation is + λ = 0 i = 1, 2, . . . , n − 1 (A2.52) However, eqn A2.50 has exactly the same form as this equation, so the maximum or minimum of f can be found by solving + λ = 0 i = 1, 2, . . . , n (A2.53) The use of this approach was illustrated in the text for two constraints and therefore two undetermined multipliers λ1 and λ2 (α and −β). The multipliers λ cannot always remain undetermined. One approach is to solve eqn A2.50 instead of incorporating it into the minimization scheme. In Chapter 16 we used the alternative procedure of keeping λ undetermined until a property was calculated for which the value was already known. Thus, we found that β = 1/kT by calculating the internal energy of a perfect gas. D F ∂g ∂xi A C D F ∂f ∂xi A C D F ∂g ∂xi A C D F ∂f ∂xi A C 5 6 7 D F ∂g ∂xi A C D F ∂f ∂xi A C 1 2 3 D F ∂g ∂xn A C D F ∂f ∂xn A C 5 6 7 D F ∂g ∂xi A C D F ∂f ∂xi A C 1 2 3 D F ∂g ∂xi A C D F ∂f ∂xi A C D F ∂f ∂xi A C A2.9 DIFFERENTIAL EQUATIONS 971 A2.9 Differential equations (a) Ordinary differential equations An ordinary differential equation is a relation between derivatives of a function of one variable and the function itself, as in a + b + cy = 0 (A2.54) The coefficients a, b, etc. may be functions of x. The order of the equation is the order of the highest derivative that occurs in it, so eqn A2.54 is a second-order equation. Only rarely in science is a differential equation of order higher than 2 encountered. A solution of a differential equation is an expression for y as a function of x. The process of solving a differential equation is commonly termed ‘integration’, and in simple cases simple integration can be employed to find y(x). A general solution of a differential equation is the most general solution of the equation and is expressed in terms of a number of constants. When the constants are chosen to accord with certain specified initial conditions (if one variable is the time) or certain boundary conditions (to fulfil certain spatial restrictions on the solutions), we obtain the particular solution of the equation. A first–order differential equation requires the specification of one boundary (or initial) condition; a second–order differential equation requires the specification of two such conditions, and so on. First-order differential equations may often be solved by direct integration. For example, the equation = axy with a constant may be rearranged into = axdx and then integrated to ln y = 1 –2ax2 + A where A is a constant. If we know that y = y0 when x = 0 (for instance), then it follows that A = ln y0, and hence the particular solution of the equation is ln y = 1 –2ax2 + ln y0 This expression rearranges to y = y0eax2 /2 First-order equations of a more complex form can often be solved by the appropriate substitution. For example, it is sensible to try the substitution y = sx, and to change the variables from x and y to x and s. An alternative useful transformation is to write x = u + a and y = v + b, and then to select a and b to simplify the form of the resulting expression. Solutions to complicated differential equations may also be found by referring to tables (see Further reading). For example, first-order equations of the form + yf(x) = g(x) (A2.55) dy dx dy y dy dx dy dx d2 y dx2 972 Appendix 2 MATHEMATICAL TECHNIQUES appear in the study of chemical kinetics. The solution is given by ye∫f(x)dx = Ύe∫f(x)dx g(x)dx + constant (A2.56) Mathematical software is now capable of finding analytical solutions of a wide variety of differential equations. Second-order differential equations are in general much more difficult to solve than first-order equations. One powerful approach commonly used to lay siege to second-order differential equations is to express the solution as a power series: y = ∞ ∑ n=0 cnxn (A2.57) and then to use the differential equation to find a relation between the coefficients. This approach results, for instance, in the Hermite polynomials that form part of the solution of the Schrödinger equation for the harmonic oscillator (Section 9.4). All the second-order differential equations that occur in this text are tabulated in compilations of solutions or can be solved with mathematical software, and the specialized techniques that are needed to establish the form of the solutions may be found in mathematical texts. (b) Numerical integration of differential equations Many of the differential equations that describe physical phenomena are so complicated that their solutions cannot be cast as functions. In such cases, we resort to numerical methods, in which approximations are made in order to integrate the differential equation. Software packages are now readily available that can be used to solve almost any equation numerically. The general form of such programs to solve df/dx = g(x), for instance, replaces the infinitesimal quantity df = g(x)dx by the small quantity ∆f = g(x)∆x, so that f(x + ∆x) ≈ f(x) + g(x)∆x and then proceeds numerically to step along the x-axis, generating f(x) as it goes. The actual algorithms adopted are much more sophisticated than this primitive scheme, but stem from it. Among the simple numerical methods, the fourth-order Runge– Kutta method is one of the most accurate. The Further reading section lists monographs that discuss the derivation of the fourth-order Runge–Kutta method. Here we illustrate the procedure with a first-order differential equation of the form: = f(x,y) (A2.58) One example of this differential equation in chemical kinetics is eqn 22.36, which describes the time dependence of the concentration of an intermediate I in the reaction sequence A → I → P. To obtain an approximate value of the integral of eqn A2.58, we proceed by rewriting it in terms of finite differences instead of differentials: = f(x,y) where ∆y may also be written as y(x + ∆x) − y(x). The fourth-order Runge–Kutta method is based on the following approximation: y(x + ∆x) = y(x) + 1 –6(k1 + 2k2 + 2k3 + k4) (A2.59) ∆y ∆x dy dx A2.10 RANDOM SELECTIONS 973 where k1 = f(x,y)∆x (A2.60a) k2 = f(x + 1 –2∆x, y + 1 –2k1)∆x (A2.60b) k3 = f(x + 1 –2∆x, y + 1 –2k2)∆x (A2.60c) k4 = f(x + ∆x, y + k3)∆x (A2.60d) Therefore, if we know the functional form of f(x,y) and y(0), we can use eqns A2.60(a–d) to calculate values of y for a range of x values. The process can be automated easily with an electronic spreadsheet or with mathematical software. The accuracy of the calculation increases with decreasing values of the increment ∆x. (c) Partial differential equations A partialdifferentialequation is a differential in more than one variable. An example is = a (A2.61) with y a function of the two variables x and t. In certain cases, partial differential equations may be separated into ordinary differential equations. Thus, the Schrödinger equation for a particle in a two-dimensional square well (Section 9.2) may be separated by writing the wavefunction, ψ(x,y), as the product X(x)Y(y), which results in the separation of the second-order partial differential equation into two second-order differential equations in the variables x and y. A good guide to the likely success of such a separation of variables procedure is the symmetry of the system. Statistics and probability Throughout the text, but especially in Chapters 16, 17, 19, and 21, we use several elementary results from two branches of mathematics: probability theory, which deals with quantities and events that are distributed randomly, and statistics, which provides tools for the analysis of large collections of data. Here we introduce some of the fundamental ideas from these two fields. A2.10 Random selections Combinatorial functions allow us to express the number of ways in which a system of particles may be configured; they are especially useful in statistical thermodynamics (Chapters 16 and 17). Consider a simple coin-toss problem. If n coins are tossed, the number N(n,i) of outcomes that have i heads and (n − i) tails, regardless of the order of the results, is given by the coefficients of the binomial expansion of (1 + x)n : (1 + x)n = 1 + n ∑ i=1 N(n,i)xi , N(n,i) = (A2.62) The numbers N(n,i), which are sometimes denoted , are also called binomial coefficients. Suppose that, unlike the coin-toss problem, there are more than two possible results for each event. For example, there are six possible results for the roll of a die. For n rolls of the die, the number of ways, W, that correspond to n1 occurrences of the number 1, n2 occurrences of the number 2, and so on, is given by D F n i A C n! (n − i)!i! ∂2 y ∂x2 ∂2 y ∂t2 974 Appendix 2 MATHEMATICAL TECHNIQUES W = , n = 6 ∑ i=1 ni This is an example of a multinomial coefficient, which has the form W = , n = m ∑ i=1 ni (A2.63) where W is the number of ways of achieving an outcome, n is the number of events, and m is the number of possible results. In Chapter 16 we use the multinomial coefficient to determine the number of ways to configure a system of identical particles given a specific distribution of particles into discrete energy levels. In chemistry it is common to deal with a very large number of particles and outcomes and it is useful to express factorials in different ways. We can simplify factorials of large numbers by using Stirling’s approximation: n! ≈ (2π)1/2 nn+1 –2e−n (A2.64) The approximation is in error by less than 1 per cent when n is greater than about 10. For very large values of n, it is possible to use another form of the approximation: ln n! ≈ n ln n − n (A2.65) A2.11 Some results of probability theory Here we develop two general results of probability theory: the mean value of a variable and the mean value of a function. The calculation of mean values is useful in the description of random coils (Chapter 19) and molecular diffusion (Chapter 21). The mean value (also called the expectation value) ͗X͘ of a variable X is calculated by first multiplying each discrete value xi that X can have by the probability pi that xi occurs and then summing these products over all possible N values of X: ͗X͘ = N ∑ i=1 xipi When N is very large and the xi values are so closely spaced that X can be regarded as varying continuously, it is useful to express the probability that X can have a value between x and x + dx as Probability of finding a value of X between x and x + dx = f(x)dx where the function f(x) is the probability density, a measure of the distribution of the probability values over x, and dx is an infinitesimally small interval of x values. It follows that the probability that X has a value between x = a and x = b is the integral of the expression above evaluated between a and b: Probability of finding a value of X between a and b = Ύ b a f(x)dx The mean value of the continuously varying X is given by ͗X͘ = Ύ +∞ −∞ xf(x)dx (A2.66) This expression is similar to that written for the case of discrete values of X, with f(x)dx as the probability term and integration over the closely spaced x values replacing summation over widely spaced xi. n! n1!n2! . . . nm! n! n1!n2!n3!n4!n5!n6! A2.12 MATRIX ADDITION AND MULTIPLICATION 975 The mean value of a function g(X) can be calculated with a formula similar to that for ͗X͘: ͗g(X)͘ = Ύ +∞ −∞ g(x)f(x)dx (A2.67) Matrix algebra A matrix is an array of numbers. Matrices may be combined together by addition or multiplication according to generalizations of the rules for ordinary numbers. Most numerical matrix manipulations are now carried out with mathematical software. Consider a square matrix M of n2 numbers arranged in n columns and n rows. These n2 numbers are the elements of the matrix, and may be specified by stating the row, r, and column, c, at which they occur. Each element is therefore denoted Mrc. For example, in the matrix M = the elements are M11 = 1, M12 = 2, M21 = 3, and M22 = 4. This is an example of a 2 × 2 matrix. The determinant, |M|, of this matrix is |M| = = 1 × 4 − 2 × 3 = −2 A diagonal matrix is a matrix in which the only nonzero elements lie on the major diagonal (the diagonal from M11 to Mnn). Thus, the matrix D = is diagonal. The condition may be written Mrc = mrδrc (A2.68) where δrc is the Kronecker delta, which is equal to 1 for r = c and to 0 for r ≠ c. In the above example, m1 = 1, m2 = 2, and m3 = 1. The unit matrix, 1 (and occasionally I), is a special case of a diagonal matrix in which all nonzero elements are 1. The transpose of a matrix M is denoted MT and is defined by MT mn = Mnm (A2.69) Thus, for the matrix M we have been using, MT = Matrices are very useful in chemistry. They simplify some mathematical tasks, such as solving systems of simultaneous equations, the treatment of molecular symmetry (Chapter 12), and quantum mechanical calculations (Chapter 11). A2.12 Matrix addition and multiplication Two matrices M and N may be added to give the sum S = M + N, according to the rule Src = Mrc + Nrc (A2.70) 1 3 2 4 ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ 1 0 0 0 2 0 0 0 1 ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ ⎟ 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ 976 Appendix 2 MATHEMATICAL TECHNIQUES (that is, corresponding elements are added). Thus, with M given above and N = the sum is S = Two matrices may also be multiplied to give the productP = MN according to the rule Prc = ∑ n MrnNnc (A2.71) For example, with the matrices given above, P = It should be noticed that in general MN ≠ NM, and matrix multiplication is in general non-commutative. The inverse of a matrix M is denoted M−1 , and is defined so that MM−1 = M−1 M = 1 (A2.72) The inverse of a matrix can be constructed by using mathematical software, but in simple cases the following procedure can be carried through without much effort: 1 Form the determinant of the matrix. For example, for our matrix M, |M| = −2. 2 Form the transpose of the matrix. For example, MT = . 3 Form *′, where *′rc is the cofactor of the element Mrc, that is, it is the determinant formed from M with the row r and column c struck out. For example, *′ = 4 Construct the inverse as M−1 = *′/|M|. For example, M−1 = 1 ––−2 A2.13 Simultaneous equations A set of n simultaneous equations a11x1 + a12x2 + · · · + a1nxn = b1 a21x1 + a22x2 + · · · + a2nxn = b2 Ӈ (A2.73) an1x1 + an2x2 + · · · + annxn = bn can be written in matrix notation if we introduce the column vectors x and b: x = b = b b bn 1 2 M ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎜ ⎜⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ ⎟ ⎟⎟ x x xn 1 2 M ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎜ ⎜⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ ⎟ ⎟⎟ 4 2 3 1 2 1 3 2 1 2 − − ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ = − − ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ 4 2 3 1 − − ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ 1 3 2 4 ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 5 2 7 1 6 2 8 3 5 4 7 3 6 4 8 19 22 43 50 ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ = × + × × + × × + × × + × ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ = ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 6 8 10 12 ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ + ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ = ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ 5 6 7 8 ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ A2.14 EIGENVALUE EQUATIONS 977 Then, with the a matrix of coefficients arc, the n equations may be written as ax = b (A2.74) The formal solution is obtained by multiplying both sides of this matrix equation by a−1 , for then x = a−1 b (A2.75) A2.14 Eigenvalue equations An eigenvalue equation is a special case of eqn A2.74 in which ax = λx (A2.76) where λ is a constant, the eigenvalue, and x is the eigenvector. In general, there are n eigenvalues λ(i) , and they satisfy the n simultaneous equations (a − λ1)x = 0 (A2.77) There are n corresponding eigenvectors x(i) . Equation A2.77 has a solution only if the determinant of the coefficients is zero. However, this determinant is just |a − λ1|, so the n eigenvalues may be found from the solution of the secular equation: |a − λ1| = 0 (A2.78) The n eigenvalues the secular equation yields may be used to find the n eigenvectors. These eigenvectors (which are n × 1 matrices), may be used to form an n × n matrix X. Thus, because x(1) = x(2) = etc. we may form the matrix X = (x(1) , x(2) , . . . , x(n) ) = so that Xrc = xr (c) . If further we write Λrc = λrδrc, so that L is a diagonal matrix with the elements λ1, λ2, . . . , λn along the diagonal, then all the eigenvalue equations ax(i) = lix(i) may be confined into the single equation aX = XL (A2.79) because this expression is equal to ∑ n arnXnc = ∑ n XrnΛnc or ∑ n arnxn (c) = ∑ n xr (n) λnδnc = λcxr (c) asrequired.Therefore,ifweformX−1 fromX,weconstructasimilaritytransformation L = X−1 aX (A2.80) x x x x x x x x x n n n n n n 1 1 1 2 1 2 1 2 2 2 1 2 ( ) ( ) ( ) ( ) ( ) ( ) ( ) ( ) ( ) L L M M M L ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎜ ⎜ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ ⎟ ⎟ ⎟ x x xn 1 2 2 2 2 ( ) ( ) ( ) M ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎜ ⎜ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ ⎟ ⎟ ⎟ x x xn 1 1 2 1 1 ( ) ( ) ( ) M ⎛ ⎝ ⎜ ⎜ ⎜ ⎜ ⎞ ⎠ ⎟ ⎟ ⎟ ⎟ 978 Appendix 2 MATHEMATICAL TECHNIQUES that makes a diagonal (because L is diagonal). It follows that if the matrix X that causes X−1 aX to be diagonal is known, then the problem is solved: the diagonal matrix so produced has the eigenvalues as its only nonzero elements, and the matrix X used to bring about the transformation has the corresponding eigenvectors as its columns. The solutions of eigenvalue equations are best found by using mathematical software. Further reading P.W. Atkins, J.C. de Paula, and V.A. Walters, Explorations in physical chemistry. W.H. Freeman and Company, New York (2005). J.R. Barrante, Applied mathematics for physical chemistry. Prentice Hall, Upper Saddle River (2004). M.P. Cady and C.A. Trapp, A Mathcad primer for physical chemistry. W.H. Freeman and Company, New York (2000). R.G. Mortimer, Mathematics for physical chemistry. Academic Press, San Diego (2005). D.A. McQuarrie, Mathematical methods for scientists and engineers. University Science Books, Sausalito (2003). D. Zwillinger (ed.), CRC standard mathematical tables and formulae. CRC Press, Boca Raton (1996). Appendix 3 Essential concepts of physics Energy The central concept of all explanations in physical chemistry, as in so many other branches of physical science, is that of energy, the capacity to do work. We make use of the apparently universal law of nature that energy is conserved, that is, energy can neither be created nor destroyed. Although energy can be transferred from one location to another, the total energy is constant. A3.1 Kinetic and potential energy The kinetic energy, EK, of a body is the energy the body possesses as a result of its motion. For a body of mass m travelling at a speed v, EK = 1 –2mv2 (A3.1) The potential energy, EP or V, of a body is the energy it possesses as a result of its position. The zero of potential energy is arbitrary. For example, the gravitational potential energy of a body is often set to zero at the surface of the Earth; the electrical potential energy of two charged particles is set to zero when their separation is infinite. No universal expression for the potential energy can be given because it depends on the type of interaction the body experiences. One example that gives rise to a simple expression is the potential energy of a body of mass m in the gravitational field close to the surface of the Earth (a gravitational field acts on the mass of a body). If the body is at a height h above the surface of the Earth, then its potential energy is mgh, where g is a constant called the acceleration of free fall, g = 9.81 m s−2 , and V = 0 at h = 0 (the arbitrary zero mentioned previously). The total energy is the sum of the kinetic and potential energies of a particle: E = EK + EP (A3.2) A3.2 Energy units The SI unit of energy is the joule (J), which is defined as 1 J = 1 kg m2 s−2 (A3.3) Calories (cal) and kilocalories (kcal) are still encountered in the chemical literature: by definition, 1 cal = 4.184 J. An energy of 1 cal is enough to raise the temperature of 1 g of water by 1°C. The rate of change of energy is called the power, P, expressed as joules per second, or watt, W: 1 W = 1 J s−1 (A3.4) A3 Energy A3.1 Kinetic and potential energy A3.2 Energy units Classical mechanics A3.3 The trajectory in terms of the energy A3.4 Newton’s second law A3.5 Rotational motion A3.6 The harmonic oscillator Waves A3.7 The electromagnetic field A3.8 Features of electromagnetic radiation A3.9 Refraction A3.10 Optical activity Electrostatics A3.11 The Coulomb interaction A2.12 The Coulomb potential A2.13 The strength of the electric field A2.14 Electric current and power Further reading 980 Appendix 3 ESSENTIAL CONCEPTS OF PHYSICS Classical mechanics Classical mechanics describes the behaviour of objects in terms of two equations. One expresses the fact that the total energy is constant in the absence of external forces; the other expresses the response of particles to the forces acting on them. A3.3 The trajectory in terms of the energy The velocity, V, of a particle is the rate of change of its position: V = (A3.5) The velocity is a vector, with both direction and magnitude. The magnitude of the velocity is the speed, v. The linear momentum, p, of a particle of mass m is related to its velocity, V, by p = mV (A3.6) Like the velocity vector, the linear momentum vector points in the direction of travel of the particle (Fig. A3.1). In terms of the linear momentum, the total energy of a particle is E = + V(x) (A3.7) This equation can be used to show that a particle will have a definite trajectory, or definite position and momentum at each instant. For example, consider a particle free to move in one direction (along the x-axis) in a region where V = 0 (so the energy is independent of position). Because v = dx/dt, it follows from eqns A3.6 and A3.7 that = 1/2 (A3.8) A solution of this differential equation is x(t) = x(0) + m 1/2 t (A3.9) The linear momentum is a constant: p(t) = mv(t) = m = (2mEK)1/2 (A3.10) Hence, if we know the initial position and momentum, we can predict all later positions and momenta exactly. A3.4 Newton’s second law The force, F, experienced by a particle free to move in one dimension is related to its potential energy, V, by F = − (A3.11a) This relation implies that the direction of the force is towards decreasing potential energy (Fig. A3.2). In three dimensions, dV dx dx dt D F 2EK m A C D F 2EK m A C dx dt p2 2m dr dt p pz px py Fig. A3.1 The linear momentum of a particle is a vector property and points in the direction of motion. Potentialenergy,V Position, x Force Force Fig. A3.2 The force acting on a particle is determined by the slope of the potential energy at each point. The force points in the direction of lower potential energy. A3.5 ROTATIONAL MOTION 981 F = −∇V ∇ = i + j + k (A3.11b) Newton’s second law of motion states that the rate of change of momentum is equal to the force acting on the particle. In one dimension: = F (A3.12a) Because p = m(dx/dt) in one dimension, it is sometimes more convenient to write this equation as m = F (A3.12b) The second derivative, d2 x/dt2 , is the acceleration of the particle, its rate of change of velocity (in this instance, along the x-axis). It follows that, if we know the force acting everywhere and at all times, then solving eqn A3.12 will also give the trajectory. This calculation is equivalent to the one based on E, but is more suitable in some applications. For example, it can be used to show that, if a particle of mass m is initially stationary and is subjected to a constant force F for a time τ, then its kinetic energy increases from zero to EK = (A3.13) and then remains at that energy after the force ceases to act. Because the applied force, F, and the time, τ, for which it acts may be varied at will, the solution implies that the energy of the particle may be increased to any value. A3.5 Rotational motion The rotational motion of a particle about a central point is described by its angular momentum, J. The angular momentum is a vector: its magnitude gives the rate at which a particle circulates and its direction indicates the axis of rotation (Fig. A3.3). The magnitude of the angular momentum, J, is given by the expression J = Iω (A3.14) where ω is the angular velocity of the body, its rate of change of angular position (in radians per second), and I is the moment of inertia. The analogous roles of m and I, of v and ω, and of p and J in the translational and rotational cases, respectively, should be remembered, because they provide a ready way of constructing and recalling equations. For a point particle of mass m moving in a circle of radius r, the moment of inertia about the axis of rotation is given by the expression I = mr2 (A3.15) To accelerate a rotation it is necessary to apply a torque, T, a twisting force. Newton’s equation is then = T (A3.16) If a constant torque is applied for a time τ, the rotational energy of an initially stationary body is increased to dJ dt F2 τ2 2m d2 x dt2 dp dt ∂ ∂z ∂ ∂y ∂ ∂x J Fig. A3.3 The angular momentum of a particle is represented by a vector along the axis of rotation and perpendicular to the plane of rotation. The length of the vector denotes the magnitude of the angular momentum. The direction of motion is clockwise to an observer looking in the direction of the vector. 982 Appendix 3 ESSENTIAL CONCEPTS OF PHYSICS EK = (A3.17) The implication of this equation is that an appropriate torque and period for which it is applied can excite the rotation to an arbitrary energy. A3.6 The harmonic oscillator A harmonic oscillator consists of a particle that experiences a restoring force proportional to its displacement from its equilibrium position: F = −kx (A3.18) An example is a particle joined to a rigid support by a spring. The constant of proportionality k is called the force constant, and the stiffer the spring the greater the force constant. The negative sign in F signifies that the direction of the force is opposite to that of the displacement (Fig. A3.4). The motion of a particle that undergoes harmonic motion is found by substituting the expression for the force, eqn A3.18, into Newton’s equation, eqn A3.12b. The resulting equation is m = −kx A solution is x(t) = A sin ωt p(t) = mωA cos ωt ω = (k/m)1/2 (A3.19) These solutions show that the position of the particle varies harmonically (that is, as sin ωt) with a frequency ν = ω/2π. They also show that the particle is stationary (p = 0) when the displacement, x, has its maximum value, A, which is called the amplitude of the motion. The total energy of a classical harmonic oscillator is proportional to the square of the amplitude of its motion. To confirm this remark we note that the kinetic energy is EK = = = 1 –2mω2 A2 cos 2ωt (A3.20) Then, because ω = (k/m)1/2 , this expression may be written EK = 1 –2kA2 cos2 ωt (A3.21) The force on the oscillator is F = −kx, so it follows from the relation F = −dV/dx that the potential energy of a harmonic oscillator is V = 1 –2kx2 = 1 –2kA2 sin2 ωt (A3.22) The total energy is therefore E = 1 –2kA2 cos2 ωt + 1 –2kA2 sin2 ωt = 1 –2kA2 (A3.23) (We have used cos2 ωt + sin2 ωt = 1.) That is, the energy of the oscillator is constant and, for a given force constant, is determined by its maximum displacement. It follows that the energy of an oscillating particle can be raised to any value by stretching the spring to any desired amplitude A. Note that the frequency of the motion depends only on the inherent properties of the oscillator (as represented by k and m) and is independent of the energy; the amplitude governs the energy, through E = 1 –2kA2 , and is independent of the frequency. In other words, the particle will oscillate at the same frequency regardless of the amplitude of its motion. (mωA cos ωt)2 2m p2 2m d2 x dt2 T2 τ2 2I Displacement, x 0 Potentialenergy,V Force Fig. A3.4 The force acting on a particle that undergoes harmonic motion. The force is directed towards zero displacement and is proportional to the displacement. The corresponding potential energy is parabolic (proportional to x2 ). A3.8 FEATURES OF ELECTROMAGNETIC RADIATION 983 Waves Waves are disturbances that travel through space with a finite velocity. Examples of disturbances include the collective motion of water molecules in ocean waves and of gas particles in sound waves. Waves can be characterized by a wave equation, a differential equation that describes the motion of the wave in space and time. Harmonic waves are waves with displacements that can be expressed as sine or cosine functions. These concepts are used in classical physics to describe the wave character of electromagnetic radiation, which is the focus of the following discussion. A3.7 The electromagnetic field In classical physics, electromagnetic radiation is understood in terms of the electromagnetic field, an oscillating electric and magnetic disturbance that spreads as a harmonic wave through empty space, the vacuum. The wave travels at a constant speed called the speed of light, c, which is about 3 × 108 m s−1 . As its name suggests, an electromagnetic field has two components, an electric field that acts on charged particles (whether stationary of moving) and a magnetic field that acts only on moving charged particles. The electromagnetic field is characterized by a wavelength, λ (lambda), the distance between the neighbouring peaks of the wave, and its frequency, ν (nu), the number of times per second at which its displacement at a fixed point returns to its original value (Fig. A3.5). The frequency is measured in hertz, where 1 Hz = 1 s−1 . The wavelength and frequency of an electromagnetic wave are related by λν = c (A3.24) Therefore, the shorter the wavelength, the higher the frequency. The characteristics of a wave are also reported by giving the wavenumber, # (nu tilde), of the radiation, where # = = (A3.25) A wavenumber can be interpreted as the number of complete wavelengths in a given length. Wavenumbers are normally reported in reciprocal centimetres (cm−1 ), so a wavenumber of 5 cm−1 indicates that there are 5 complete wavelengths in 1 cm. The classification of the electromagnetic field according to its frequency and wavelength is summarized in Fig. A3.6. A3.8 Features of electromagnetic radiation Consider an electromagnetic disturbance travelling along the x direction with wavelength λ and frequency ν. The functions that describe the oscillating electric field, E(x,t), and magnetic field, B(x,t), may be written as E(x,t) = E0cos{2πνt − (2π/λ)x + φ} (A3.26a) B(x,t) = B0cos{2πνt − (2π/λ)x + φ} (A3.26b) where E0 and B0 are the amplitudes of the electric and magnetic fields, respectively, and the parameter φ is the phase of the wave, which varies from −π to π and gives the relative location of the peaks of two waves. If two waves, in the same region of space, with the same wavelength are shifted by φ = π or −π (so the peaks of one wave coincide with the troughs of the other), then the resultant wave will have diminished 1 λ ν c Wavelength, (a) (b) l Fig. A3.5 (a) The wavelength, λ, of a wave is the peak-to-peak distance. (b) The wave is shown travelling to the right at a speed c. At a given location, the instantaneous amplitude of the wave changes through a complete cycle (the four dots show half a cycle) as it passes a given point. The frequency, ν, is the number of cycles per second that occur at a given point. Wavelength and frequency are related by λν = c. 984 Appendix 3 ESSENTIAL CONCEPTS OF PHYSICS amplitudes. The waves are said to interfere destructively. A value of φ = 0 (coincident peaks) corresponds to constructive interference, or the enhancement of the amplitudes. Equations A3.26a and A3.26b represent electromagnetic radiation that is planepolarized; it is so called because the electric and magnetic fields each oscillate in a single plane (in this case the xy-plane, Fig. A3.7). The plane of polarization may be orientated in any direction around the direction of propagation (the x-direction in Fig. A3.7), with the electric and magnetic fields perpendicular to that direction (and perpendicular to each other). An alternative mode of polarization is circular polarization, in which the electric and magnetic fields rotate around the direction of propagation in either a clockwise or a counterclockwise sense but remain perpendicular to it and each other. It is easy to show by differentiation that eqns A3.26a and A3.26b satisfy the following equations: ψ(x,t) = − ψ(x,t) ψ(x,t) = −4π2 ν2 ψ(x,t) (A3.27) where ψ(x,t) is either E(x,t) or B(x,t). According to classical electromagnetic theory, the intensity of electromagnetic radiation is proportional to the square of the amplitude of the wave. For example, the light detectors discussed in Further information 16.1 are based on the interaction between the electric field of the incident radiation and the detecting element, so light intensities are proportional to E2 0. A3.9 Refraction A beam of light changes direction (‘bends’) when it passes from one transparent medium to another. This effect, called refraction, depends on the refractiveindex, nr, of the medium, the ratio of the speed of light in a vacuum, c, to its speed c′ in the medium: nr = [A3.28] It follows from the Maxwell equations (see Further reading), that the refractive index at a (visible or ultraviolet) specified frequency is related to the relative permittivity εr (discussed in Section 20.10) at that frequency by nr = εr 1/2 (A3.29) Table A3.1 lists refractive indices of some materials. Because the relative permittivity of a medium is related to its polarizability by eqn 20.10, the refractive index is related to the polarizability. To see why this is so, we need to realize that propagation of light through a medium induces an oscillating dipole moment, which then radiates light of the same frequency. The newly generated radiation is delayed slightly by this process, so it propagates more slowly through the medium than through a vacuum. Because photons of high-frequency light carry more energy than those of low-frequency light, they can distort the electronic distributions of the molecules in their path more effectively. Therefore, after allowing for the loss of contributions from low-frequency modes of motion, we can expect the electronic polarizabilities of molecules, and hence the refractive index, to increase as the incident frequency rises towards an absorption frequency. This dependence on frequency is the origin of the dispersion of white light by a prism: the refractive index is greater for blue light than for red, and therefore the blue rays are bent more than the red. The c c′ ∂2 ∂t2 4π2 λ2 ∂2 ∂x2 10-14 10-13 10-12 10 -11 10 -10 10 -9 10-8 10 -7 10 -6 10 -5 10 -4 10-3 10-2 10-1 1 1 pm 1 nm 1 mm 1 mm 1 cm 1 dm 1 m Radio Micro- wave Far infrared Near infrared Ultraviolet Vacuum ultraviolet X-ray g-ray Cosmic rays Wavelength/m Molecular rotation Molecular vibration Electronic excitation Core-electron excitation Nuclear excitation Visible Red Violet Green 700 nm 420 nm g Fig. A3.6 The regions of the electromagnetic spectrum and the types of excitation that give rise to each region. A3.10 OPTICAL ACTIVITY 985 term dispersion is a term carried over from this phenomenon to mean the variation of the refractive index, or of any property, with frequency. A3.10 Optical activity The concept of refractive index is closely related to the property of optical activity. An optically active substance is a substance that rotates the plane of polarization of plane-polarized light. To understand this effect, it is useful to regard the incident plane-polarized beam as a superposition of two oppositely rotating circularly polarized components. By convention, in right-handed circularly polarized light the electric vector rotates clockwise as seen by an observer facing the oncoming beam (Fig. A3.8). On entering the medium, one component propagates faster than the other if their refractive indices are different. If the sample is of length l, the difference in the times of passage is ∆t = − where cR and cL are the speeds of the two components in the medium. In terms of the refractive indices, the difference is ∆t = (nR − nL) The phase difference between the two components when they emerge from the sample is therefore ∆θ = 2πν∆t = = (nR − nL) where λ is the wavelength of the light. The two rotating electric vectors have a different phase when they leave the sample from the value they had initially, so their superposition gives rise to a plane-polarized beam rotated through an angle ∆θ relative to the plane of the incoming beam. It follows that the angle of optical rotation is proportional to the difference in refractive index, nR − nL. A sample in which these two refractive indices are different is said to be circularly birefringent. To explain why the refractive indices depend on the handedness of the light, we must examine why the polarizabilities depend on the handedness. One interpretation is that, if a molecule is helical (such as a polypeptide α-helix described in Section 19.7) or a crystal has molecules in a helical arrangement (as in a cholesteric liquid crystal, as described in Impact I6.1), its polarizability depends on whether or not the electric field of the incident radiation rotates in the same sense as the helix. Associated with the circular birefringence of the medium is a difference in absorption intensities for right- and left-circularly polarized radiation. This difference is known as circular dichroism, which is explored in Chapter 14. Electrostatics Electrostatics is the study of the interactions of stationary electric charges. The elementary charge, the magnitude of charge carried by a single electron or proton, is e ≈ 1.60 × 10−19 C. The magnitude of the charge per mole is Faraday’s constant: F = NAe = 9.65 × 104 C mol−1 . 2πl λ 2πc∆t λ l c l cR l cL Plane of polarization Right Left Resultant Fig. A3.8 The superposition of left and right circularly polarized light as viewed from an observer facing the oncoming beam. Synoptic table A3.1* Refractive indices relative to air at 20°C 434 nm 589 nm 656 nm C6H6(l) 1.524 1.501 1.497 CS2(l) 1.675 1.628 1.618 H2O(l) 1.340 1.333 1.331 KI(s) 1.704 1.666 1.658 * More values are given in the Data section. y x z E0 B0 Fig. A3.7 Electromagnetic radiation consists of a wave of electric and magnetic fields perpendicular to the direction of propagation (in this case the x-direction), and mutually perpendicular to each other. This illustration shows a plane-polarized wave, with the electric and magnetic fields oscillating in the xy- and xz-planes, respectively. 986 Appendix 3 ESSENTIAL CONCEPTS OF PHYSICS A3.11 The Coulomb interaction If a point charge q1 is at a distance r in a vacuum from another point charge q2, then their potential energy is V = (A3.30) The constant ε0 is the vacuum permittivity, a fundamental constant with the value 8.85 × 10−12 C2 J−1 m−1 . This very important relation is called the Coulomb potential energy and the interaction it describes is called the Coulomb interaction of two charges. The Coulomb potential energy is equal to the work that must be done to bring up a charge q1 from infinity to a distance r from a charge q2. It follows from eqns A3.5 and A3.30 that the electrical force, F, exerted by a charge q1 on a second charge q2 has magnitude F = (A3.31) The force itself is a vector directed along the line joining the two charges. With charge in coulombs and distance in metres, the force is obtained in newtons. In a medium other than a vacuum, the potential energy of interaction between two charges is reduced, and the vacuum permittivity is replaced by the permittivity, ε, of the medium (see Section 18.3). A3.12 The Coulomb potential The potential energy of a charge q1 in the presence of another charge q2 can be expressed in terms of the Coulomb potential, φ: V = q1φ φ = (A3.32) The units of potential are joules per coulomb, J C−1 , so, when ϕ is multiplied by a charge in coulombs, the result is in joules. The combination joules per coulomb occurs widely in electrostatics, and is called a volt, V: 1 V = 1 J C−1 (A3.33) If there are several charges q2, q3, . . . present in the system, the total potential experienced by the charge q1 is the sum of the potential generated by each charge: φ = φ2 + φ3 + · · · (A3.34) When the charge distribution is more complex than a single point–like object, the Coulomb potential is described in terms of a charge density, ρ. With charge in coulomb and length in metres, the charge density is expressed in coulombs per metre-cubed (C m−3 ). The electric potential arising from a charge distribution with density ρ is the solution to Poisson’s equation: ∇2 φ = −ρ/ε0 (A3.35) where ∇2 = (∂2 /∂x2 + ∂2 /∂y2 + ∂2 /∂z2 ). If the distribution is spherically symmetrical, then so too is φ and eqn A3.35 reduces to the form used in Further information 5.1. A3.13 The strength of the electric field Just as the potential energy of a charge q1 can be written V = q1φ, so the magnitude of the force on q1 can be written F = q1E, where E is the magnitude of the electric field q2 4πε0r q1q2 4πε0r2 q1q2 4πε0r FURTHER READING 987 strength arising from q2 or from some more general charge distribution. The electric field strength (which, like the force, is actually a vector quantity) is the negative gradient of the electric potential: / = −∇φ (A3.36) A3.14 Electric current and power The motion of charge gives rise to an electric current, I. Electric current is measured in ampere, A, where 1 A = 1 C s−1 (A3.37) If the current flows from a region of potential φi to φf, through a potential difference ∆φ = φf − φi, the rate of doing work is the current (the rate of transfer of charge) multiplied by the potential difference, I∆φ. The rate of doing electrical work is the electrical power, P, so P = I∆φ (A3.38) With current in amperes and the potential difference in volts, the power works out in watts. The total energy, E, supplied in an interval ∆t is the power (the rate of energy supply) multiplied by the duration of the interval: E = P∆t = I∆φ∆t (A3.39) The energy is obtained in joules with the current in amperes, the potential difference in volts, and the time in seconds. Further reading R.P. Feynman, R.B. Leighton, and M. Sands, The Feynman lectures on physics. Vols 1–3. Addison–Wesley, Reading (1966). G.A.D. Ritchie and D.S. Sivia, Foundations of physics for chemists. Oxford Chemistry Primers, Oxford University Press (2000). W.S. Warren, The physical basis of chemistry. Academic Press, San Diego (2000). R. Wolfson and J.M. Pasachoff, Physics for scientists and engineers. Benjamin Cummings, San Francisco (1999). Contents The following is a directory of all tables in the text; those included in this Data section are marked with an asterisk. The remainder will be found on the pages indicated. Physical properties of selected materials* Masses and natural abundances of selected nuclides* 1.1 Pressure units (4) 1.2 The gas constant in various units (9) 1.3 The composition of dry air at sea level (11) 1.4 Second virial coefficients* 1.5 Critical constants of gases* 1.6 van der Waals coefficients* 1.7 Selected equations of state (19) 2.1 Varieties of work (34) 2.2 Temperature variation of molar heat capacities* 2.3 Standard enthalpies of fusion and vaporization at the transition temperature* 2.4 Enthalpies of transition [notation] (51) 2.5 Thermodynamic data for organic compounds* 2.6 Thermochemical properties of some fuels (53) 2.7 Thermodynamic data for inorganic compounds* 2.7a Standard enthalpies of hydration at infinite dilution* 2.7b Standard ion hydration enthalpies* 2.8 Expansion coefficients and isothermal compressibilities* 2.9 Inversion temperatures, normal freezing and boiling points, and Joule–Thomson coefficients* 3.1 Standard entropies (and temperatures) of phase transitions* 3.2 Standard entropies of vaporization of liquids* 3.3 Standard Third-Law entropies [see Tables 2.5 and 2.7]* 3.4 Standard Gibbs energies of formation [see Tables 2.5 and 2.7]* 3.5 The Maxwell relations (104) 3.6 The fugacity of nitrogen* 5.1 Henry’s law constants for gases* 5.2 Freezing point and boiling point constants* 5.3 Standard states [summary of definitions] (158) 5.4 Ionic strength and molality (164) 5.5 Mean activity coefficients in water* 5.6 Relative permitivities (dielectric constants)* Data section 7.1 Varieties of electrode (216) 7.2 Standard potentials* 7.3 The electrochemical series of metals (*) 7.4 Acidity constants for aqueous solutions* 8.1 The Schrödinger equation (255) 8.2 Constraints of the uncertainty principle (271) 9.1 The Hermite polynomials (293) 9.2 The error function* 9.3 The spherical harmonics (302) 9.4 Properties of angular momentum (309) 10.1 Hydrogenic radial wavefunctions (324) 10.2 Effective nuclear charge* 10.3 Ionization energies* 10.4 Electron affinities* 11.1 Some hybridization schemes (368) 11.2 Bond lengths* 11.3 Bond dissociation enthalpies* 11.4 Pauling and Mulliken electronegativities* 11.5 Ab initio calculations and spectroscopic data (398) 12.1 The notation for point groups (408) 12.2 The C2v character table (415) 12.3 The C3v character table (416) 13.1 Moments of inertia [formulae] (440) 13.2 Properties of diatomic molecules* 13.3 Typical vibrational wavenumbers* 14.1 Colour, frequency, and energy of light* 14.2 Ground and excited states of O2 (483) 14.3 Absorption characteristics of some groups and molecules* 14.4 Characteristics of laser radiation and their chemical applications (500) 15.1 Nuclear spin and nuclear structure (515) 15.2 Nuclear spin properties* 15.3 Hyperfine coupling constants for atoms* 17.1 Rotational and vibrational temperatures [see also Table 13.2] (594) DATA SECTION 989 17.2 Symmetry numbers [see also Table 13.2] (596) 17.3 Contributions to the molecular partition function [formulae] (615) 17.4 Thermodynamic functions in terms of the partition function [formulae] (616) 17.5 Contributions to mean energies and heat capacities [formulae] (616) 18.1 Dipole moments, polarizabilities, and polarizability volumes* 18.2 Partial charges in polypeptides (622) 18.3 Multipole interaction energies (630) 18.4 Lennard-Jones (12,6)-potential parameters* 18.5 Surface tensions of liquids* 19.1 Radius of gyration* 19.2 Diffusion coefficients in water* 19.3 Frictional coefficients and molecular geometry* 19.4 Intrinsic viscosity* 20.1 The seven crystal systems (699) 20.2 The crystal structures of some elements (716) 20.3 Ionic radii* 20.4 Madelung constants (719) 20.5 Lattice enthalpies* 20.6 Magnetic susceptibilities* 21.1 Collision cross-sections* 21.2 Transport properties of gases* 21.3 Transport properties of perfect gases [summary of formulae] (758) 21.4 Viscosities of liquids* 21.5 Limiting ionic conductivities in water* 21.6 Ionic mobilities in water* 21.7 Debye–Hückel–Onsager coefficients for (1,1)- electrolytes* 21.8 Diffusion coefficients* 22.1 Kinetic data for first-order reactions* 22.2 Kinetic data for second-order reactions* 22.3 Integrated rate laws (803) 22.4 Arrhenius parameters* 23.1 Photochemical processes (846) 23.2 Common photophysical processes (846) 23.3 Values of R0 for donor–acceptor pairs (852) 24.1 Arrhenius parameters for gas-phase reactions* 24.2 Arrhenius parameters for reactions in solution [see Table 22.4]* 24.3 Summary of uses of k [notation] (902) 25.1 Maximum observed enthalpies of physisorption* 25.2 Enthalpies of chemisorption* 25.3 Activation energies of catalysed reactions* 25.4 Properties of catalysts (929) 25.5 Chemisorption abilities (930) 25.6 Exchange current densities and transfer coefficients* 25.7 Summary of acronyms (950) A1.1 The SI base units (960) A1.2 A selection of derived units (961) A1.3 Common SI prefixes (961) A1.4 Some common units (962) A3.1 Refractive indices relative to air* Character tables The following tables reproduce and expand the data given in the short tables in the text, and follow their numbering. Standard states refer to a pressure of p7 = 1 bar. The general references are as follows: AIP: D.E. Gray (ed.), American Institute of Physics handbook. McGraw Hill, New York (1972). AS: M. Abramowitz and I.A. Stegun (ed.), Handbook of mathematical functions. Dover, New York (1963). E: J. Emsley, The elements. Oxford University Press (1991). HCP: D.R. Lide (ed.), Handbook of chemistry and physics. CRC Press, Boca Raton (2000). JL: A.M. James and M.P. Lord, Macmillan’s chemical and physical data. Macmillan, London (1992). KL: G.W.C. Kaye and T.H. Laby (ed.), Tables of physical and chemical constants. Longman, London (1973). LR: G.N. Lewis and M. Randall, resived by K.S. Pitzer and L. Brewer, Thermodynamics. McGraw-Hill, New York (1961). NBS: NBS tables of chemical thermodynamic properties, published as J. Phys. and Chem. Reference Data, 11, Supplement 2 (1982). RS: R.A. Robinson and R.H. Stokes, Electrolyte solutions. Butterworth, London (1959). TDOC: J.B. Pedley, J.D. Naylor, and S.P. Kirby, Thermochemical data of organic compounds. Chapman & Hall, London (1986). 990 DATA SECTION Physical properties of selected materials r/(g cm−3 ) Tf /K Tb/K r/(g cm−3 ) Tf /K Tb/K at 293 K† at 293 K† Elements Aluminium(s) 2.698 933.5 2740 Argon(g) 1.381 83.8 87.3 Boron(s) 2.340 2573 3931 Bromine(l) 3.123 265.9 331.9 Carbon(s, gr) 2.260 3700s Carbon(s, d) 3.513 Chlorine(g) 1.507 172.2 239.2 Copper(s) 8.960 1357 2840 Fluorine(g) 1.108 53.5 85.0 Gold(s) 19.320 1338 3080 Helium(g) 0.125 4.22 Hydrogen(g) 0.071 14.0 20.3 Iodine(s) 4.930 386.7 457.5 Iron(s) 7.874 1808 3023 Krypton(g) 2.413 116.6 120.8 Lead(s) 11.350 600.6 2013 Lithium(s) 0.534 453.7 1620 Magnesium(s) 1.738 922.0 1363 Mercury(l) 13.546 234.3 629.7 Neon(g) 1.207 24.5 27.1 Nitrogen(g) 0.880 63.3 77.4 Oxygen(g) 1.140 54.8 90.2 Phosphorus(s, wh) 1.820 317.3 553 Potassium(s) 0.862 336.8 1047 Silver(s) 10.500 1235 2485 Sodium(s) 0.971 371.0 1156 Sulfur(s, α) 2.070 386.0 717.8 Uranium(s) 18.950 1406 4018 Xenon(g) 2.939 161.3 166.1 Zinc(s) 7.133 692.7 1180 d: decomposes; s: sublimes; Data: AIP, E, HCP, KL. † For gases, at their boiling points. Inorganic compounds CaCO3(s, calcite) 2.71 1612 1171d CuSO4·5H2O(s) 2.284 383(–H2O) 423(–5H2O) HBr(g) 2.77 184.3 206.4 HCl(g) 1.187 159.0 191.1 HI(g) 2.85 222.4 237.8 H2O(l) 0.997 273.2 373.2 D2O(l) 1.104 277.0 374.6 NH3(g) 0.817 195.4 238.8 KBr(s) 2.750 1003 1708 KCl(s) 1.984 1049 1773s NaCl(s) 2.165 1074 1686 H2SO4(l) 1.841 283.5 611.2 Organic compounds Acetaldehyde, CH3CHO(l, g) 0.788 152 293 Acetic acid, CH3COOH(l) 1.049 289.8 391 Acetone, (CH3)2CO(l) 0.787 178 329 Aniline, C6H5NH2(l) 1.026 267 457 Anthracene, C14H10(s) 1.243 490 615 Benzene, C6H6(l) 0.879 278.6 353.2 Carbon tetrachloride, CCl4(l) 1.63 250 349.9 Chloroform, CHCl3(l) 1.499 209.6 334 Ethanol, C2H5OH(l) 0.789 156 351.4 Formaldehyde, HCHO(g) 181 254.0 Glucose, C6H12O6(s) 1.544 415 Methane, CH4(g) 90.6 111.6 Methanol, CH3OH(l) 0.791 179.2 337.6 Naphthalene, C10H8(s) 1.145 353.4 491 Octane, C8H18(l) 0.703 216.4 398.8 Phenol, C6H5OH(s) 1.073 314.1 455.0 Sucrose, C12H22O11(s) 1.588 457d DATA SECTION 991 Table 1.5 Critical constants of gases pc/atm Vc/(cm3 mol−1 ) Tc/K Zc TB/K Ar 48.00 75.25 150.72 0.292 411.5 Br2 102 135 584 0.287 C2H4 50.50 124 283.1 0.270 C2H6 48.20 148 305.4 0.285 C6H6 48.6 260 562.7 0.274 CH4 45.6 98.7 190.6 0.288 510.0 Cl2 76.1 124 417.2 0.276 CO2 72.85 94.0 304.2 0.274 714.8 F2 55 144 H2 12.8 64.99 33.23 0.305 110.0 H2O 218.3 55.3 647.4 0.227 HBr 84.0 363.0 HCl 81.5 81.0 324.7 0.248 He 2.26 57.76 5.21 0.305 22.64 HI 80.8 423.2 Kr 54.27 92.24 209.39 0.291 575.0 N2 33.54 90.10 126.3 0.292 327.2 Ne 26.86 41.74 44.44 0.307 122.1 NH3 111.3 72.5 405.5 0.242 O2 50.14 78.0 154.8 0.308 405.9 Xe 58.0 118.8 289.75 0.290 768.0 Data: AIP, KL. Masses and natural abundances of selected nuclides Nuclide m/u Abundance/% H 1 H 1.0078 99.985 2 H 2.0140 0.015 He 3 He 3.0160 0.000 13 4 He 4.0026 100 Li 6 Li 6.0151 7.42 7 Li 7.0160 92.58 B 10 B 10.0129 19.78 11 B 11.0093 80.22 C 12 C 12* 98.89 13 C 13.0034 1.11 N 14 N 14.0031 99.63 15 N 15.0001 0.37 O 16 O 15.9949 99.76 17 O 16.9991 0.037 18 O 17.9992 0.204 F 19 F 18.9984 100 P 31 P 30.9738 100 S 32 S 31.9721 95.0 33 S 32.9715 0.76 34 S 33.9679 4.22 Cl 35 Cl 34.9688 75.53 37 Cl 36.9651 24.4 Br 79 Br 78.9183 50.54 81 Br 80.9163 49.46 I 127 I 126.9045 100 * Exact value. Table 1.4 Second virial coefficients, B/(cm3 mol−1 ) 100 K 273 K 373 K 600 K Air −167.3 −13.5 3.4 19.0 Ar −187.0 −21.7 −4.2 11.9 CH4 −53.6 −21.2 8.1 CO2 −142 −72.2 −12.4 H2 −2.0 13.7 15.6 He 11.4 12.0 11.3 10.4 Kr −62.9 −28.7 1.7 N2 −160.0 −10.5 6.2 21.7 Ne −6.0 10.4 12.3 13.8 O2 −197.5 −22.0 −3.7 12.9 Xe −153.7 −81.7 −19.6 Data: AIP, JL. The values relate to the expansion in eqn 1.22 of Section 1.3b; convert to eqn 1.21 using B′ = B/RT. For Ar at 273 K, C = 1200 cm6 mol−1 . 992 DATA SECTION Table 1.6 van der Waals coefficients a/(atm dm6 mol−2 ) b/(10−2 dm3 mol−1 ) a/(atm dm6 mol−2 ) b/(10−2 dm3 mol−1 ) Ar 1.337 3.20 H2S 4.484 4.34 C2H4 4.552 5.82 He 0.0341 2.38 C2H6 5.507 6.51 Kr 5.125 1.06 C6H6 18.57 11.93 N2 1.352 3.87 CH4 2.273 4.31 Ne 0.205 1.67 Cl2 6.260 5.42 NH3 4.169 3.71 CO 1.453 3.95 O2 1.364 3.19 CO2 3.610 4.29 SO2 6.775 5.68 H2 0.2420 2.65 Xe 4.137 5.16 H2O 5.464 3.05 Data: HCP. Table 2.2 Temperature variation of molar heat capacities† a b/(10−3 K−1 ) c/(105 K2 ) Monatomic gases 20.78 0 0 Other gases Br2 37.32 0.50 −1.26 Cl2 37.03 0.67 −2.85 CO2 44.22 8.79 −8.62 F2 34.56 2.51 −3.51 H2 27.28 3.26 0.50 I2 37.40 0.59 −0.71 N2 28.58 3.77 −0.50 NH3 29.75 25.1 −1.55 O2 29.96 4.18 −1.67 Liquids (from melting to boiling) C10H8, naphthalene 79.5 0.4075 0 I2 80.33 0 0 H2O 75.29 0 0 Solids Al 20.67 12.38 0 C (graphite) 16.86 4.77 −8.54 C10H8, naphthalene −115.9 3.920 × 103 0 Cu 22.64 6.28 0 I2 40.12 49.79 0 NcCl 45.94 16.32 0 Pb 22.13 11.72 0.96 † For Cp,m/(J K−1 mol−1 ) = a + bT + c/T2 . Source: LR. DATA SECTION 993 Table 2.5 Thermodynamic data for organic compounds (all values are for 298 K) M/(g mol−1 ) DfH7 /(kJ mol−1 ) DfG7 /(kJ mol−1 ) Sm 7 /(J K−1 mol−1 )† C 7 p,m/(J K−1 mol−1 ) DcH7 /(kJ mol−1 ) C(s) (graphite) 12.011 0 0 5.740 8.527 −393.51 C(s) (diamond) 12.011 +1.895 +2.900 2.377 6.113 −395.40 CO2(g) 44.040 −393.51 −394.36 213.74 37.11 Hydrocarbons CH4(g), methane 16.04 −74.81 −50.72 186.26 35.31 −890 CH3(g), methyl 15.04 +145.69 +147.92 194.2 38.70 C2H2(g), ethyne 26.04 +226.73 +209.20 200.94 43.93 −1300 C2H4(g), ethene 28.05 +52.26 +68.15 219.56 43.56 −1411 C2H6(g), ethane 30.07 −84.68 −32.82 229.60 52.63 −1560 C3H6(g), propene 42.08 +20.42 +62.78 267.05 63.89 −2058 C3H6(g), cyclopropane 42.08 +53.30 +104.45 237.55 55.94 −2091 C3H8(g), propane 44.10 −103.85 −23.49 269.91 73.5 −2220 C4H8(g), 1-butene 56.11 −0.13 +71.39 305.71 85.65 −2717 C4H8(g), cis-2-butene 56.11 −6.99 +65.95 300.94 78.91 −2710 C4H8(g), trans-2-butene 56.11 −11.17 +63.06 296.59 87.82 −2707 C4H10(g), butane 58.13 −126.15 −17.03 310.23 97.45 −2878 C5H12(g), pentane 72.15 −146.44 −8.20 348.40 120.2 −3537 C5H12(l) 72.15 −173.1 C6H6(l), benzene 78.12 +49.0 +124.3 173.3 136.1 −3268 Table 2.3 Standard enthalpies of fusion and vaporization at the transition temperature, ∆trsH7 /(kJ mol−1 ) Tf /K Fusion Tb/K Vaporization Tf /K Fusion Tb/K Vaporization Elements Ag 1234 11.30 2436 250.6 Ar 83.81 1.188 87.29 6.506 Br2 265.9 10.57 332.4 29.45 Cl2 172.1 6.41 239.1 20.41 F2 53.6 0.26 85.0 3.16 H2 13.96 0.117 20.38 0.916 He 3.5 0.021 4.22 0.084 Hg 234.3 2.292 629.7 59.30 I2 386.8 15.52 458.4 41.80 N2 63.15 0.719 77.35 5.586 Na 371.0 2.601 1156 98.01 O2 54.36 0.444 90.18 6.820 Xe 161 2.30 165 12.6 K 336.4 2.35 1031 80.23 Inorganic compounds CCl4 250.3 2.47 349.9 30.00 Data: AIP; s denotes sublimation. CO2 217.0 8.33 194.6 25.23 s CS2 161.2 4.39 319.4 26.74 H2O 273.15 6.008 373.15 40.656 44.016 at 298 K H2S 187.6 2.377 212.8 18.67 H2SO4 283.5 2.56 NH3 195.4 5.652 239.7 23.35 Organic compounds CH4 90.68 0.941 111.7 8.18 CCl4 250.3 2.5 350 30.0 C2H6 89.85 2.86 184.6 14.7 C6H6 278.61 10.59 353.2 30.8 C6H14 178 13.08 342.1 28.85 C10H8 354 18.80 490.9 51.51 CH3OH 175.2 3.16 337.2 35.27 37.99 at 298 K C2H5OH 158.7 4.60 352 43.5 994 DATA SECTION Hydrocarbons (Continued) C6H6(g) 78.12 +82.93 +129.72 269.31 81.67 −3302 C6H12(l), cyclohexane 84.16 −156 +26.8 204.4 156.5 −3920 C6H14(l), hexane 86.18 −198.7 204.3 −4163 C6H5CH3(g), methylbenzene (toluene) 92.14 +50.0 +122.0 320.7 103.6 −3953 C7H16(l), heptane 100.21 −224.4 +1.0 328.6 224.3 C8H18(l), octane 114.23 −249.9 +6.4 361.1 −5471 C8H18(l), iso-octane 114.23 −255.1 −5461 C10H8(s), naphthalene 128.18 +78.53 −5157 Alcohols and phenols CH3OH(l), methanol 32.04 −238.66 −166.27 126.8 81.6 −726 CH3OH(g) 32.04 −200.66 −161.96 239.81 43.89 −764 C2H5OH(l), ethanol 46.07 −277.69 −174.78 160.7 111.46 −1368 C2H5OH(g) 46.07 −235.10 −168.49 282.70 65.44 −1409 C6H5OH(s), phenol 94.12 −165.0 −50.9 146.0 −3054 Carboxylic acids, hydroxy acids, and esters HCOOH(l), formic 46.03 −424.72 −361.35 128.95 99.04 −255 CH3COOH(l), acetic 60.05 −484.5 −389.9 159.8 124.3 −875 CH3COOH(aq) 60.05 −485.76 −396.46 178.7 CH3CO2 − (aq) 59.05 −486.01 −369.31 +86.6 −6.3 (COOH)2(s), oxalic 90.04 −827.2 117 −254 C6H5COOH(s), benzoic 122.13 −385.1 −245.3 167.6 146.8 −3227 CH3CH(OH)COOH(s), lactic 90.08 −694.0 −1344 CH3COOC2H5(l), ethyl acetate 88.11 −479.0 −332.7 259.4 170.1 −2231 Alkanals and alkanones HCHO(g), methanal 30.03 −108.57 −102.53 218.77 35.40 −571 CH3CHO(l), ethanal 44.05 −192.30 −128.12 160.2 −1166 CH3CHO(g) 44.05 −166.19 −128.86 250.3 57.3 −1192 CH3COCH3(l), propanone 58.08 −248.1 −155.4 200.4 124.7 −1790 Sugars C6H12O6(s), α-d-glucose 180.16 −1274 −2808 C6H12O6(s), β-d-glucose 180.16 −1268 −910 212 C6H12O6(s), β-d-fructose 180.16 −1266 −2810 C12H22O11(s), sucrose 342.30 −2222 −1543 360.2 −5645 Nitrogen compounds CO(NH2)2(s), urea 60.06 −333.51 −197.33 104.60 93.14 −632 CH3NH2(g), methylamine 31.06 −22.97 +32.16 243.41 53.1 −1085 C6H5NH2(l), aniline 93.13 +31.1 −3393 CH2(NH2)COOH(s), glycine 75.07 −532.9 −373.4 103.5 99.2 −969 Data: NBS, TDOC. † Standard entropies of ions may be either positive or negative because the values are relative to the entropy of the hydrogen ion. Table 2.5 (Continued) M/(g mol−1 ) DfH7 /(kJ mol−1 ) DfG7 /(kJ mol−1 ) Sm 7 /(J K−1 mol−1 )† C 7 p,m/(J K−1 mol−1 ) DcH7 /(kJ mol−1 ) DATA SECTION 995 Table 2.7 Thermodynamic data for elements and inorganic compounds (all values relate to 298 K) M/(g mol−1 ) DfH7 /(kJ mol−1 ) DfG7 /(kJ mol−1 ) Sm 7 /(J K−1 mol−1 )† C 7 p,m/(J K−1 mol−1 ) Aluminium (aluminum) Al(s) 26.98 0 0 28.33 24.35 Al(l) 26.98 +10.56 +7.20 39.55 24.21 Al(g) 26.98 +326.4 +285.7 164.54 21.38 Al3+ (g) 26.98 +5483.17 Al3+ (aq) 26.98 −531 −485 −321.7 Al2O3(s, α) 101.96 −1675.7 −1582.3 50.92 79.04 AlCl3(s) 133.24 −704.2 −628.8 110.67 91.84 Argon Ar(g) 39.95 0 0 154.84 20.786 Antimony Sb(s) 121.75 0 0 45.69 25.23 SbH3(g) 124.77 +145.11 +147.75 232.78 41.05 Arsenic As(s, α) 74.92 0 0 35.1 24.64 As(g) 74.92 +302.5 +261.0 174.21 20.79 As4(g) 299.69 +143.9 +92.4 314 AsH3(g) 77.95 +66.44 +68.93 222.78 38.07 Barium Ba(s) 137.34 0 0 62.8 28.07 Ba(g) 137.34 +180 +146 170.24 20.79 Ba2+ (aq) 137.34 −537.64 −560.77 +9.6 BaO(s) 153.34 −553.5 −525.1 70.43 47.78 BaCl2(s) 208.25 −858.6 −810.4 123.68 75.14 Beryllium Be(s) 9.01 0 0 9.50 16.44 Be(g) 9.01 +324.3 +286.6 136.27 20.79 Bismuth Bi(s) 208.98 0 0 56.74 25.52 Bi(g) 208.98 +207.1 +168.2 187.00 20.79 Bromine Br2(l) 159.82 0 0 152.23 75.689 Br2(g) 159.82 +30.907 +3.110 245.46 36.02 Br(g) 79.91 +111.88 +82.396 175.02 20.786 Br− (g) 79.91 −219.07 Br− (aq) 79.91 −121.55 −103.96 +82.4 −141.8 HBr(g) 90.92 −36.40 −53.45 198.70 29.142 Cadmium Cd(s, γ) 112.40 0 0 51.76 25.98 Cd(g) 112.40 +112.01 +77.41 167.75 20.79 Cd2+ (aq) 112.40 −75.90 −77.612 −73.2 996 DATA SECTION Table 2.7 (Continued) M/(g mol−1 ) DfH7 /(kJ mol−1 ) DfG7 /(kJ mol−1 ) Sm 7 /(J K−1 mol−1 )† C 7 p,m/(J K−1 mol−1 ) Cadmium (Continued) CdO(s) 128.40 −258.2 −228.4 54.8 43.43 CdCO3(s) 172.41 −750.6 −669.4 92.5 Caesium (cesium) Cs(s) 132.91 0 0 85.23 32.17 Cs(g) 132.91 +76.06 +49.12 175.60 20.79 Cs+ (aq) 132.91 −258.28 −292.02 +133.05 −10.5 Calcium Ca(s) 40.08 0 0 41.42 25.31 Ca(g) 40.08 +178.2 +144.3 154.88 20.786 Ca2+ (aq) 40.08 −542.83 −553.58 −53.1 CaO(s) 56.08 −635.09 −604.03 39.75 42.80 CaCO3(s) (calcite) 100.09 −1206.9 −1128.8 92.9 81.88 CaCO3(s) (aragonite) 100.09 −1207.1 −1127.8 88.7 81.25 CaF2(s) 78.08 −1219.6 −1167.3 68.87 67.03 CaCl2(s) 110.99 −795.8 −748.1 104.6 72.59 CaBr2(s) 199.90 −682.8 −663.6 130 Carbon (for ‘organic’ compounds of carbon, see Table 2.5) C(s) (graphite) 12.011 0 0 5.740 8.527 C(s) (diamond) 12.011 +1.895 +2.900 2.377 6.113 C(g) 12.011 +716.68 +671.26 158.10 20.838 C2(g) 24.022 +831.90 +775.89 199.42 43.21 CO(g) 28.011 −110.53 −137.17 197.67 29.14 CO2(g) 44.010 −393.51 −394.36 213.74 37.11 CO2(aq) 44.010 −413.80 −385.98 117.6 H2CO3(aq) 62.03 −699.65 −623.08 187.4 HCO3 − (aq) 61.02 −691.99 −586.77 +91.2 CO3 2− (aq) 60.01 −677.14 −527.81 −56.9 CCl4(l) 153.82 −135.44 −65.21 216.40 131.75 CS2(l) 76.14 +89.70 +65.27 151.34 75.7 HCN(g) 27.03 +135.1 +124.7 201.78 35.86 HCN(l) 27.03 +108.87 +124.97 112.84 70.63 CN− (aq) 26.02 +150.6 +172.4 +94.1 Chlorine Cl2(g) 70.91 0 0 223.07 33.91 Cl(g) 35.45 +121.68 +105.68 165.20 21.840 Cl− (g) 34.45 −233.13 Cl− (aq) 35.45 −167.16 −131.23 +56.5 −136.4 HCl(g) 36.46 −92.31 −95.30 186.91 29.12 HCl(aq) 36.46 −167.16 −131.23 56.5 −136.4 Chromium Cr(s) 52.00 0 0 23.77 23.35 Cr(g) 52.00 +396.6 +351.8 174.50 20.79 DATA SECTION 997 Table 2.7 (Continued) M/(g mol−1 ) DfH7 /(kJ mol−1 ) DfG7 /(kJ mol−1 ) Sm 7 /(J K−1 mol−1 )† C 7 p,m/(J K−1 mol−1 ) Chromium (Continued) CrO4 2− (aq) 115.99 −881.15 −727.75 +50.21 Cr2O7 2− (aq) 215.99 −1490.3 −1301.1 +261.9 Copper Cu(s) 63.54 0 0 33.150 24.44 Cu(g) 63.54 +338.32 +298.58 166.38 20.79 Cu+ (aq) 63.54 +71.67 +49.98 +40.6 Cu2+ (aq) 63.54 +64.77 +65.49 −99.6 Cu2O(s) 143.08 −168.6 −146.0 93.14 63.64 CuO(s) 79.54 −157.3 −129.7 42.63 42.30 CuSO4(s) 159.60 −771.36 −661.8 109 100.0 CuSO4·H2O(s) 177.62 −1085.8 −918.11 146.0 134 CuSO4·5H2O(s) 249.68 −2279.7 −1879.7 300.4 280 Deuterium D2(g) 4.028 0 0 144.96 29.20 HD(g) 3.022 +0.318 −1.464 143.80 29.196 D2O(g) 20.028 −249.20 −234.54 198.34 34.27 D2O(l) 20.028 −294.60 −243.44 75.94 84.35 HDO(g) 19.022 −245.30 −233.11 199.51 33.81 HDO(l) 19.022 −289.89 −241.86 79.29 Fluorine F2(g) 38.00 0 0 202.78 31.30 F(g) 19.00 +78.99 +61.91 158.75 22.74 F− (aq) 19.00 −332.63 −278.79 −13.8 −106.7 HF(g) 20.01 −271.1 −273.2 173.78 29.13 Gold Au(s) 196.97 0 0 47.40 25.42 Au(g) 196.97 +366.1 +326.3 180.50 20.79 Helium He(g) 4.003 0 0 126.15 20.786 Hydrogen (see also deuterium) H2(g) 2.016 0 0 130.684 28.824 H(g) 1.008 +217.97 +203.25 114.71 20.784 H+ (aq) 1.008 0 0 0 0 H+ (g) 1.008 +1536.20 H2O(s) 18.015 37.99 H2O(l) 18.015 −285.83 −237.13 69.91 75.291 H2O(g) 18.015 −241.82 −228.57 188.83 33.58 H2O2(l) 34.015 −187.78 −120.35 109.6 89.1 Iodine I2(s) 253.81 0 0 116.135 54.44 I2(g) 253.81 +62.44 +19.33 260.69 36.90 998 DATA SECTION Table 2.7 (Continued) M/(g mol−1 ) DfH7 /(kJ mol−1 ) DfG7 /(kJ mol−1 ) Sm 7 /(J K−1 mol−1 )† C 7 p,m/(J K−1 mol−1 ) Iodine (Continued) I(g) 126.90 +106.84 +70.25 180.79 20.786 I− (aq) 126.90 −55.19 −51.57 +111.3 −142.3 HI(g) 127.91 +26.48 +1.70 206.59 29.158 Iron Fe(s) 55.85 0 0 27.28 25.10 Fe(g) 55.85 +416.3 +370.7 180.49 25.68 Fe2+ (aq) 55.85 −89.1 −78.90 −137.7 Fe3+ (aq) 55.85 −48.5 −4.7 −315.9 Fe3O4(s) (magnetite) 231.54 −1118.4 −1015.4 146.4 143.43 Fe2O3(s) (haematite) 159.69 −824.2 −742.2 87.40 103.85 FeS(s, α) 87.91 −100.0 −100.4 60.29 50.54 FeS2(s) 119.98 −178.2 −166.9 52.93 62.17 Krypton Kr(g) 83.80 0 0 164.08 20.786 Lead Pb(s) 207.19 0 0 64.81 26.44 Pb(g) 207.19 +195.0 +161.9 175.37 20.79 Pb2+ (aq) 207.19 −1.7 −24.43 +10.5 PbO(s, yellow) 223.19 −217.32 −187.89 68.70 45.77 PbO(s, red) 223.19 −218.99 −188.93 66.5 45.81 PbO2(s) 239.19 −277.4 −217.33 68.6 64.64 Lithium Li(s) 6.94 0 0 29.12 24.77 Li(g) 6.94 +159.37 +126.66 138.77 20.79 Li+ (aq) 6.94 −278.49 −293.31 +13.4 68.6 Magnesium Mg(s) 24.31 0 0 32.68 24.89 Mg(g) 24.31 +147.70 +113.10 148.65 20.786 Mg2+ (aq) 24.31 −466.85 −454.8 −138.1 MgO(s) 40.31 −601.70 −569.43 26.94 37.15 MgCO3(s) 84.32 −1095.8 −1012.1 65.7 75.52 MgCl2(s) 95.22 −641.32 −591.79 89.62 71.38 Mercury Hg(l) 200.59 0 0 76.02 27.983 Hg(g) 200.59 +61.32 +31.82 174.96 20.786 Hg2+ (aq) 200.59 +171.1 +164.40 −32.2 Hg2 2+ (aq) 401.18 +172.4 +153.52 +84.5 HgO(s) 216.59 −90.83 −58.54 70.29 44.06 Hg2Cl2(s) 472.09 −265.22 −210.75 192.5 102 HgCl2(s) 271.50 −224.3 −178.6 146.0 HgS(s, black) 232.65 −53.6 −47.7 88.3 DATA SECTION 999 Table 2.7 (Continued) M/(g mol−1 ) DfH7 /(kJ mol−1 ) DfG7 /(kJ mol−1 ) Sm 7 /(J K−1 mol−1 )† C 7 p,m/(J K−1 mol−1 ) Neon Ne(g) 20.18 0 0 146.33 20.786 Nitrogen N2(g) 28.013 0 0 191.61 29.125 N(g) 14.007 +472.70 +455.56 153.30 20.786 NO(g) 30.01 +90.25 +86.55 210.76 29.844 N2O(g) 44.01 +82.05 +104.20 219.85 38.45 NO2(g) 46.01 +33.18 +51.31 240.06 37.20 N2O4(g) 92.1 +9.16 +97.89 304.29 77.28 N2O5(s) 108.01 −43.1 +113.9 178.2 143.1 N2O5(g) 108.01 +11.3 +115.1 355.7 84.5 HNO3(l) 63.01 −174.10 −80.71 155.60 109.87 HNO3(aq) 63.01 −207.36 −111.25 146.4 −86.6 NO3 − (aq) 62.01 −205.0 −108.74 +146.4 −86.6 NH3(g) 17.03 −46.11 −16.45 192.45 35.06 NH3(aq) 17.03 −80.29 −26.50 111.3 NH4 + (aq) 18.04 −132.51 −79.31 +113.4 79.9 NH2OH(s) 33.03 −114.2 HN3(l) 43.03 +264.0 +327.3 140.6 43.68 HN3(g) 43.03 +294.1 +328.1 238.97 98.87 N2H4(l) 32.05 +50.63 +149.43 121.21 139.3 NH4NO3(s) 80.04 −365.56 −183.87 151.08 84.1 NH4Cl(s) 53.49 −314.43 −202.87 94.6 Oxygen O2(g) 31.999 0 0 205.138 29.355 O(g) 15.999 +249.17 +231.73 161.06 21.912 O3(g) 47.998 +142.7 +163.2 238.93 39.20 OH− (aq) 17.007 −229.99 −157.24 −10.75 −148.5 Phosphorus P(s, wh) 30.97 0 0 41.09 23.840 P(g) 30.97 +314.64 +278.25 163.19 20.786 P2(g) 61.95 +144.3 +103.7 218.13 32.05 P4(g) 123.90 +58.91 +24.44 279.98 67.15 PH3(g) 34.00 +5.4 +13.4 210.23 37.11 PCl3(g) 137.33 −287.0 −267.8 311.78 71.84 PCl3(l) 137.33 −319.7 −272.3 217.1 PCl5(g) 208.24 −374.9 −305.0 364.6 112.8 PCl5(s) 208.24 −443.5 H3PO3(s) 82.00 −964.4 H3PO3(aq) 82.00 −964.8 H3PO4(s) 94.97 −1279.0 −1119.1 110.50 106.06 H3PO4(l) 94.97 −1266.9 H3PO4(aq) 94.97 −1277.4 −1018.7 −222 1000 DATA SECTION Table 2.7 (Continued) M/(g mol−1 ) DfH7 /(kJ mol−1 ) DfG7 /(kJ mol−1 ) Sm 7 /(J K−1 mol−1 )† C 7 p,m/(J K−1 mol−1 ) Phosphorus (Continued) PO4 3− (aq) 94.97 −1277.4 −1018.7 −221.8 P4O10(s) 283.89 −2984.0 −2697.0 228.86 211.71 P4O6(s) 219.89 −1640.1 Potassium K(s) 39.10 0 0 64.18 29.58 K(g) 39.10 +89.24 +60.59 160.336 20.786 K+ (g) 39.10 +514.26 K+ (aq) 39.10 −252.38 −283.27 +102.5 21.8 KOH(s) 56.11 −424.76 −379.08 78.9 64.9 KF(s) 58.10 −576.27 −537.75 66.57 49.04 KCl(s) 74.56 −436.75 −409.14 82.59 51.30 KBr(s) 119.01 −393.80 −380.66 95.90 52.30 Kl(s) 166.01 −327.90 −324.89 106.32 52.93 Silicon Si(s) 28.09 0 0 18.83 20.00 Si(g) 28.09 +455.6 +411.3 167.97 22.25 SiO2(s, α) 60.09 −910.94 −856.64 41.84 44.43 Silver Ag(s) 107.87 0 0 42.55 25.351 Ag(g) 107.87 +284.55 +245.65 173.00 20.79 Ag+ (aq) 107.87 +105.58 +77.11 +72.68 21.8 AgBr(s) 187.78 −100.37 −96.90 107.1 52.38 AgCl(s) 143.32 −127.07 −109.79 96.2 50.79 Ag2O(s) 231.74 −31.05 −11.20 121.3 65.86 AgNO3(s) 169.88 −129.39 −33.41 140.92 93.05 Sodium Na(s) 22.99 0 0 51.21 28.24 Na(g) 22.99 +107.32 +76.76 153.71 20.79 Na+ (aq) 22.99 −240.12 −261.91 59.0 46.4 NaOH(s) 40.00 −425.61 −379.49 64.46 59.54 NaCl(s) 58.44 −411.15 −384.14 72.13 50.50 NaBr(s) 102.90 −361.06 −348.98 86.82 51.38 NaI(s) 149.89 −287.78 −286.06 98.53 52.09 Sulfur S(s, α) (rhombic) 32.06 0 0 31.80 22.64 S(s, β) (monoclinic) 32.06 +0.33 +0.1 32.6 23.6 S(g) 32.06 +278.81 +238.25 167.82 23.673 S2(g) 64.13 +128.37 +79.30 228.18 32.47 S2− (aq) 32.06 +33.1 +85.8 −14.6 SO2(g) 64.06 −296.83 −300.19 248.22 39.87 SO3(g) 80.06 −395.72 −371.06 256.76 50.67 DATA SECTION 1001 Table 2.7a Standard enthalpies of hydration at infinite dilution, ∆hydH7 /(kJ mol−1 ) Li+ Na+ K+ Rb+ Cs+ F− −1026 −911 −828 −806 −782 Cl− −884 −783 −685 −664 −640 Br− −856 −742 −658 −637 −613 I− −815 −701 −617 −596 −572 Entries refer to X+ (g) + Y− (g) → X+ (aq) + Y− (aq). Data: Principally J.O’M. Bockris and A.K.N. Reddy, Modern electrochemistry, Vol. 1. Plenum Press, New York (1970). Table 2.7b Standard ion hydration enthalpies, ∆hydH7 /(kJ mol−1 ) at 298 K Cations H+ (−1090) Ag+ −464 Mg2+ −1920 Li+ −520 NH4 + −301 Ca2+ −1650 Na+ −405 Sr2+ −1480 K+ −321 Ba2+ −1360 Rb+ −300 Fe2+ −1950 Cs+ −277 Cu2+ −2100 Zn2+ −2050 Al3+ −4690 Fe3+ −4430 Anions OH− −460 F− −506 Cl− −364 Br− −337 I− −296 Entries refer to X± (g) → X± (aq) based on H+ (g) → H+ (aq); ∆H7 = −1090 kJ mol−1 . Data: Principally J.O’M. Bockris and A.K.N. Reddy, Modern electrochemistry, Vol. 1. Plenum Press, New York (1970). Table 2.7 (Continued) M/(g mol−1 ) DfH7 /(kJ mol−1 ) DfG7 /(kJ mol−1 ) Sm 7 /(J K−1 mol−1 )† C 7 p,m/(J K−1 mol−1 ) Sulfur (Continued) H2SO4(l) 98.08 −813.99 −690.00 156.90 138.9 H2SO4(aq) 98.08 −909.27 −744.53 20.1 −293 SO4 2− (aq) 96.06 −909.27 −744.53 +20.1 −293 HSO4 − (aq) 97.07 −887.34 −755.91 +131.8 −84 H2S(g) 34.08 −20.63 −33.56 205.79 34.23 H2S(aq) 34.08 −39.7 −27.83 121 HS− (aq) 33.072 −17.6 +12.08 +62.08 SF6(g) 146.05 −1209 −1105.3 291.82 97.28 Tin Sn(s, β) 118.69 0 0 51.55 26.99 Sn(g) 118.69 +302.1 +267.3 168.49 20.26 Sn2+ (aq) 118.69 −8.8 −27.2 −17 SnO(s) 134.69 −285.8 −256.9 56.5 44.31 SnO2(s) 150.69 −580.7 −519.6 52.3 52.59 Xenon Xe(g) 131.30 0 0 169.68 20.786 Zinc Zn(s) 65.37 0 0 41.63 25.40 Zn(g) 65.37 +130.73 +95.14 160.98 20.79 Zn2+ (aq) 65.37 −153.89 −147.06 −112.1 46 ZnO(s) 81.37 −348.28 −318.30 43.64 40.25 Source: NBS. † Standard entropies of ions may be either positive or negative because the values are relative to the entropy of the hydrogen ion. 1002 DATA SECTION Table 3.1 Standard entropies (and temperatures) of phase transitions, ∆trsS7 /(J K−1 mol−1 ) Fusion (at Tf) Vaporization (at Tb) Ar 14.17 (at 83.8 K) 74.53 (at 87.3 K) Br2 39.76 (at 265.9 K) 88.61 (at 332.4 K) C6H6 38.00 (at 278.6 K) 87.19 (at 353.2 K) CH3COOH 40.4 (at 289.8 K) 61.9 (at 391.4 K) CH3OH 18.03 (at 175.2 K) 104.6 (at 337.2 K) Cl2 37.22 (at 172.1 K) 85.38 (at 239.0 K) H2 8.38 (at 14.0 K) 44.96 (at 20.38 K) H2O 22.00 (at 273.2 K) 109.0 (at 373.2 K) H2S 12.67 (at 187.6 K) 87.75 (at 212.0 K) He 4.8 (at 1.8 K and 30 bar) 19.9 (at 4.22 K) N2 11.39 (at 63.2 K) 75.22 (at 77.4 K) NH3 28.93 (at 195.4 K) 97.41 (at 239.73 K) O2 8.17 (at 54.4 K) 75.63 (at 90.2 K) Data: AIP. Table 2.8 Expansion coefficients, α, and isothermal compressibilities, κT a/(10−4 K−1 ) kT /(10−6 atm−1 ) Liquids Benzene 12.4 92.1 Carbon tetrachloride 12.4 90.5 Ethanol 11.2 76.8 Mercury 1.82 38.7 Water 2.1 49.6 Solids Copper 0.501 0.735 Diamond 0.030 0.187 Iron 0.354 0.589 Lead 0.861 2.21 The values refer to 20°C. Data: AIP(α), KL(κT). Table 2.9 Inversion temperatures, normal freezing and boiling points, and Joule–Thomson coefficients at 1 atm and 298 K TI/K Tf /K Tb/K mJT/(K atm−1 ) Air 603 0.189 at 50°C Argon 723 83.8 87.3 Carbon dioxide 1500 194.7s 1.11 at 300 K Helium 40 4.22 −0.062 Hydrogen 202 14.0 20.3 −0.03 Krypton 1090 116.6 120.8 Methane 968 90.6 111.6 Neon 231 24.5 27.1 Nitrogen 621 63.3 77.4 0.27 Oxygen 764 54.8 90.2 0.31 s: sublimes. Data: AIP, JL, and M.W. Zemansky, Heat and thermodynamics. McGraw-Hill, New York (1957). DATA SECTION 1003 Table 3.6 The fugacity coefficient of nitrogen at 273 K p/atm f p/atm f 1 0.999 55 300 1.0055 10 0.9956 400 1.062 50 0.9912 600 1.239 100 0.9703 800 1.495 150 0.9672 1000 1.839 200 0.9721 Data: LR. Table 5.1 Henry’s law constants for gases at 298 K, K/(kPa kg mol−1 ) Water Benzene CH4 7.55 × 104 44.4 × 103 CO2 30.1 × 103 8.90 × 102 H2 1.28 × 105 2.79 × 104 N2 1.56 × 105 1.87 × 104 O2 7.92 × 104 Data: converted from R.J. Silbey and R.A. Alberty, Physical chemistry. Wiley, New York (2001). Table 3.2 Standard entropies of vaporization of liquids at their normal boiling point DvapH7 /(kJ mol−1 ) qb/°C DvapS 7 /(J K−1 mol−1 ) Benzene 30.8 80.1 +87.2 Carbon disulfide 26.74 46.25 +83.7 Carbon tetrachloride 30.00 76.7 +85.8 Cyclohexane 30.1 80.7 +85.1 Decane 38.75 174 +86.7 Dimethyl ether 21.51 −23 +86 Ethanol 38.6 78.3 +110.0 Hydrogen sulfide 18.7 −60.4 +87.9 Mercury 59.3 356.6 +94.2 Methane 8.18 −161.5 +73.2 Methanol 35.21 65.0 +104.1 Water 40.7 100.0 +109.1 Data: JL. Table 3.3 Standard Third-Law entropies at 298 K: see Tables 2.5 and 2.7 Table 3.4 Standard Gibbs energies of formation at 298 K: see Tables 2.5 and 2.7 1004 DATA SECTION Table 5.6 Relative permittivities (dielectric constants) at 293 K Nonpolar molecules Polar molecules Methane (at −173°C) 1.655 Water 78.54 (at 298 K) 80.10 Carbon tetrachloride 2.238 Ammonia 16.9 (at 298 K) 22.4 at −33°C Cyclohexane 2.024 Hydrogen sulfide 9.26 at −85°C 5.93 (at 283 K) Benzene 2.283 Methanol 33.0 Ethanol 25.3 Nitrobenzene 35.6 Data: HCP. Table 5.5 Mean activity coefficients in water at 298 K b/b7 HCl KCl CaCl2 H2SO4 LaCl3 In2(SO4)3 0.001 0.966 0.966 0.888 0.830 0.790 0.005 0.929 0.927 0.789 0.639 0.636 0.16 0.01 0.905 0.902 0.732 0.544 0.560 0.11 0.05 0.830 0.816 0.584 0.340 0.388 0.035 0.10 0.798 0.770 0.524 0.266 0.356 0.025 0.50 0.769 0.652 0.510 0.155 0.303 0.014 1.00 0.811 0.607 0.725 0.131 0.387 2.00 1.011 0.577 1.554 0.125 0.954 Data: RS, HCP, and S. Glasstone, Introduction to electrochemistry. Van Nostrand (1942). Table 5.2 Freezing-point and boiling-point constants Kf /(K kg mol−1 ) Kb/(K kg mol−1 ) Acetic acid 3.90 3.07 Benzene 5.12 2.53 Camphor 40 Carbon disulfide 3.8 2.37 Carbon tetrachloride 30 4.95 Naphthalene 6.94 5.8 Phenol 7.27 3.04 Water 1.86 0.51 Data: KL. DATA SECTION 1005 Table 7.2 Standard potentials at 298 K. (a) In electrochemical order Reduction half-reaction E7 /V Reduction half-reaction E7 /V Strongly oxidizing Cu2+ + e− → Cu+ +0.16 H4XeO6 + 2H+ + 2e− → XeO3 + 3H2O +3.0 Sn4+ + 2e− → Sn2+ +0.15 F2 + 2e− → 2F− +2.87 AgBr + e− → Ag + Br− +0.07 O3 + 2H+ + 2e− → O2 + H2O +2.07 Ti4+ + e− → Ti3+ 0.00 S2O8 2− + 2e− → 2SO4 2− +2.05 2H+ + 2e− → H2 0, by definition Ag2+ + e− → Ag+ +1.98 Fe3+ + 3e− → Fe −0.04 Co3+ + e− → Co2+ +1.81 O2 + H2O + 2e− → HO2 − + OH− −0.08 H2O2 + 2H+ + 2e− → 2H2O +1.78 Pb2+ + 2e− → Pb −0.13 Au+ + e− → Au +1.69 In+ + e− → In −0.14 Pb4+ + 2e− → Pb2+ +1.67 Sn2+ + 2e− → Sn −0.14 2HClO + 2H+ + 2e− → Cl2 + 2H2O +1.63 AgI + e− → Ag + I− −0.15 Ce4+ + e− → Ce3+ +1.61 Ni2+ + 2e− → Ni −0.23 2HBrO + 2H+ + 2e− → Br2 + 2H2O +1.60 Co2+ + 2e− → Co −0.28 MnO4 − + 8H+ + 5e− → Mn2+ + 4H2O +1.51 In3+ + 3e− → In −0.34 Mn3+ + e− → Mn2+ +1.51 Tl+ + e− → Tl −0.34 Au3+ + 3e− → Au +1.40 PbSO4 + 2e− → Pb + SO4 2− −0.36 Cl2 + 2e− → 2Cl− +1.36 Ti3+ + e− → Ti2+ −0.37 Cr2O7 2− + 14H+ + 6e− → 2Cr3+ + 7H2O +1.33 Cd2+ + 2e− → Cd −0.40 O3 + H2O + 2e− → O2 + 2OH− +1.24 In2+ + e− → In+ −0.40 O2 + 4H+ + 4e− → 2H2O +1.23 Cr3+ + e− → Cr2+ −0.41 ClO4 − + 2H+ + 2e− → ClO3 − + H2O +1.23 Fe2+ + 2e− → Fe −0.44 MnO2 + 4H+ + 2e− → Mn2+ + 2H2O +1.23 In3+ + 2e− → In+ −0.44 Br2 + 2e− → 2Br− +1.09 S + 2e− → S2− −0.48 Pu4+ + e− → Pu3+ +0.97 In3+ + e− → In2+ −0.49 NO3 − + 4H+ + 3e− → NO + 2H2O +0.96 U4+ + e− → U3+ −0.61 2Hg2+ + 2e− → Hg2 2+ +0.92 Cr3+ + 3e− → Cr −0.74 ClO− + H2O + 2e− → Cl− + 2OH− +0.89 Zn2+ + 2e− → Zn −0.76 Hg2+ + 2e− → Hg +0.86 Cd(OH)2 + 2e− → Cd + 2OH− −0.81 NO3 − + 2H+ + e− → NO2 + H2O +0.80 2H2O + 2e− → H2 + 2OH− −0.83 Ag+ + e− → Ag +0.80 Cr2+ + 2e− → Cr −0.91 Hg2 2+ + 2e− → 2Hg +0.79 Mn2+ + 2e− → Mn −1.18 Fe3+ + e− → Fe2+ +0.77 V2+ + 2e− → V −1.19 BrO− + H2O + 2e− → Br− + 2OH− +0.76 Ti2+ + 2e− → Ti −1.63 Hg2SO4 + 2e− → 2Hg + SO4 2− +0.62 Al3+ + 3e− → Al −1.66 MnO4 2− + 2H2O + 2e− → MnO2 + 4OH− +0.60 U3+ + 3e− → U −1.79 MnO4 − + e− → MnO4 2− +0.56 Sc3+ + 3e− → Sc −2.09 I2 + 2e− → 2I− +0.54 Mg2+ + 2e− → Mg −2.36 CU+ + e− → Cu +0.52 Ce3+ + 3e− → Ce −2.48 I3 − + 2e− → 3I− +0.53 La3+ + 3e− → La −2.52 NiOOH + H2O + e− → Ni(OH)2 + OH− +0.49 Na+ + e− → Na −2.71 Ag2CrO4 + 2e− → 2Ag + CrO4 2− +0.45 Ca2+ + 2e− → Ca −2.87 O2 + 2H2O + 4e− → 4OH− +0.40 Sr2+ + 2e− → Sr −2.89 ClO4 − + H2O + 2e− → ClO3 − + 2OH− +0.36 Ba2+ + 2e− → Ba −2.91 [Fe(CN)6]3− + e− → [Fe(CN)6]4− +0.36 Ra2+ + 2e− → Ra −2.92 Cu2+ + 2e− → Cu +0.34 Cs+ + e− → Cs −2.92 Hg2Cl2 + 2e− → 2Hg + 2Cl− +0.27 Rb+ + e− → Rb −2.93 AgCl + e− → Ag + Cl− +0.22 K+ + e− → K −2.93 Bi3+ + 3e− → Bi +0.20 Li+ + e− → Li −3.05 1006 DATA SECTION Table 7.2 Standard potentials at 298 K. (b) In electrochemical order Reduction half-reaction E7 /V Reduction half-reaction E7 /V Ag+ + e− → Ag +0.80 I2 + 2e− → 2I− +0.54 Ag2+ + e− → Ag+ +1.98 I− 3 + 2e− → 3I− +0.53 AgBr + e− → Ag + Br− +0.0713 In+ + e− → In −0.14 AgCl + e− → Ag + Cl− +0.22 In2+ + e− → In+ −0.40 Ag2CrO4 + 2e− → 2Ag + CrO4 2− +0.45 In3+ + 2e− → In+ −0.44 AgF + e− → Ag + F− +0.78 In3+ + 3e− → In −0.34 AgI + e− → Ag + I− −0.15 In3+ + e− → In2+ −0.49 Al3+ + 3e− → Al −1.66 K+ + e− → K −2.93 Au+ + e− → Au +1.69 La3+ + 3e− → La −2.52 Au3+ + 3e− → Au +1.40 Li+ + e− → Li −3.05 Ba2+ + 2e− → Ba +2.91 Mg2+ + 2e− → Mg −2.36 Be2+ + 2e− → Be −1.85 Mn2+ + 2e− → Mn −1.18 Bi3+ + 3e− → Bi +0.20 Mn3+ + e− → Mn2+ +1.51 Br2 + 2e− → 2Br− +1.09 MnO2 + 4H+ + 2e− → Mn2+ + 2H2O +1.23 BrO− + H2O + 2e− → Br− + 2OH− +0.76 MnO4 − + 8H+ + 5e− → Mn2+ + 4H2O +1.51 Ca2+ + 2e− → Ca −2.87 MnO4 − + e− → MnO4 2− +0.56 Cd(OH)2 + 2e− → Cd + 2OH− −0.81 MnO4 2− + 2H2O + 2e− → MnO2 + 4OH− +0.60 Cd2+ + 2e− → Cd −0.40 Na+ + e− → Na −2.71 Ce3+ + 3e− → Ce −2.48 Ni2+ + 2e− → Ni −0.23 Ce4+ + e− → Ce3+ +1.61 NiOOH + H2O + e− → Ni(OH)2 + OH− +0.49 Cl2 + 2e− → 2Cl− +1.36 NO3 − + 2H+ + e− → NO2 + H2O −0.80 ClO− + H2O + 2e− → Cl− + 2OH− +0.89 NO3 − + 4H+ + 3e− → NO + 2H2O +0.96 ClO4 − + 2H+ + 2e− → ClO3 − + H2O +1.23 NO3 − + H2O + 2e− → NO2 − + 2OH− +0.10 ClO4 − + H2O + 2e− → ClO3 − + 2OH− +0.36 O2 + 2H2O + 4e− → 4OH− +0.40 Co2+ + 2e− → Co −0.28 O2 + 4H+ + 4e− → 2H2O +1.23 Co3+ + e− → Co2+ +1.81 O2 +e− → O2 − −0.56 Cr2+ + 2e− → Cr −0.91 O2 + H2O + 2e− → HO2 − + OH− −0.08 Cr2O7 2− + 14H+ + 6e− → 2Cr3+ + 7H2O +1.33 O3 + 2H+ + 2e− → O2 + H2O +2.07 Cr3+ + 3e− → Cr −0.74 O3 + H2O + 2e− → O2 + 2OH− +1.24 Cr3+ + e− → Cr2+ −0.41 Pb2+ + 2e− → Pb −0.13 Cs+ + e− → Cs −2.92 Pb4+ + 2e− → Pb2+ +1.67 Cu+ + e− → Cu +0.52 PbSO4 + 2e− → Pb + SO4 2− −0.36 Cu2+ + 2e− → Cu +0.34 Pt2+ + 2e− → Pt +1.20 Cu2+ + e− → Cu+ +0.16 Pu4+ + e− → Pu3+ +0.97 F2 + 2e− → 2F− +2.87 Ra2+ + 2e− → Ra −2.92 Fe2+ + 2e− → Fe −0.44 Rb+ + e− → Rb −2.93 Fe3+ + 3e− → Fe −0.04 S + 2e− → S2− −0.48 Fe3+ + e− → Fe2+ +0.77 S2O8 2− + 2e− → 2SO4 2− +2.05 [Fe(CN)6]3− + e− → [Fe(CN)6]4− +0.36 Sc3+ + 3e− → Sc −2.09 2H+ + 2e− → H2 0, by definition Sn2+ + 2e− → Sn −0.14 2H2O + 2e− → H2 + 2OH− −0.83 Sn4+ + 2e− → Sn2+ +0.15 2HBrO + 2H+ + 2e− → Br2 + 2H2O +1.60 Sr2+ + 2e− → Sr −2.89 2HClO + 2H+ + 2e− → Cl2 + 2H2O +1.63 Ti2+ + 2e− → Ti −1.63 H2O2 + 2H+ + 2e− → 2H2O +1.78 Ti3+ + e− → Ti2+ −0.37 H4XeO6 + 2H+ + 2e− → XeO3 +3H2O +3.0 Ti4+ + e− → Ti3+ 0.00 Hg2 2+ + 2e− → 2Hg +0.79 Tl+ + e− → Tl −0.34 Hg2Cl2 + 2e− → 2Hg + 2Cl− +0.27 U3+ + 3e− → U −1.79 Hg2+ + 2e− → Hg +0.86 U4+ + e− → U3+ −0.61 2Hg2+ + 2e− → Hg2 2+ +0.92 V2+ + 2e− → V −1.19 Hg2SO4 + 2e− → 2Hg + SO4 2− +0.62 V3+ + e− → V2+ −0.26 Zn2+ + 2e− → Zn −0.76 DATA SECTION 1007 Table 7.4 Acidity constants for aqueous solutions at 298 K. (a) In order of acid strength Acid HA A− Ka pKa Hydriodic HI I− 1011 −11 Hydrobromic HBr Br− 109 −9 Hydrochloric HCl Cl− 107 −7 Sulfuric H2SO4 HSO4 − 102 −2 Perchloric* HClO4 ClO4 − 4.0 × 101 −1.6 Hydronium ion H3O+ H2O 1 0.0 Oxalic (COOH)2 HOOCCO2 − 5.6 × 10−2 1.25 Sulfurous H2SO3 HSO3 − 1.4 × 10−2 1.85 Hydrogensulfate ion HSO4 − SO4 2− 1.0 × 10−2 1.99 Phosphoric H3PO4 H2PO4 − 6.9 × 10−3 2.16 Glycinium ion + NH3CH2COOH NH2CH2COOH 4.5 × 10−3 2.35 Hydrofluoric HF F− 6.3 × 10−4 3.20 Formic HCOOH HCO2 − 1.8 × 10−4 3.75 Hydrogenoxalate ion HOOCCO2 − C2O4 2− 1.5 × 10−5 3.81 Lactic CH3CH(OH)COOH CH3CH(OH)CO2 − 1.4 × 10−4 3.86 Acetic (ethanoic) CH3COOH CH3CO2 − 1.4 × 10−5 4.76 Butanoic CH3CH2CH2COOH CH3CH2CH2CO2 − 1.5 × 10−5 4.83 Propanoic CH3CH2COOH CH3CH2CO2 − 1.4 × 10−5 4.87 Anilinium ion C6H5NH3 + C6H5NH2 1.3 × 10−5 4.87 Pyridinium ion C5H5NH+ C6H5N 5.9 × 10−6 5.23 Carbonic H2CO3 HCO3 − 4.5 × 10−7 6.35 Hydrosulfuric H2S HS− 8.9 × 10−8 7.05 Dihydrogenphosphate ion H2PO4 − HPO4 2− 6.2 × 10−8 7.21 Hypochlorous HClO ClO− 4.0 × 10−8 7.40 Hydrazinium ion NH2NH3 + NH2NH2 8 × 10−9 8.1 Hypobromous HBrO BrO− 2.8 × 10−9 8.55 Hydrocyanic HCN CN− 6.2 × 10−10 9.21 Ammonium ion NH4 + NH3 5.6 × 10−10 9.25 Boric* B(OH)3 B(OH)4 − 5.4 × 10−10 9.27 Trimethylammonium ion (CH3)3NH+ (CH3)3N 1.6 × 10−10 9.80 Phenol C6H5OH C6H5O− 1.0 × 10−10 9.99 Hydrogencarbonate ion HCO3 − CO3 2− 4.8 × 10−11 10.33 Hypoiodous HIO IO− 3 × 10−11 10.5 Ethylammonium ion CH3CH2NH3 + CH3CH2NH2 2.2 × 10−11 10.65 Methylammonium ion CH3NH3 + CH3NH2 2.2 × 10−11 10.66 Dimethylammonium ion (CH3)2NH2 + (CH3)2NH 1.9 × 10−11 10.73 Triethylammonium ion (CH3CH2)3NH+ (CH3CH2)3N 1.8 × 10−11 10.75 Diethylammonium ion (CH3CH2)2NH2 + (CH3CH2)2NH 1.4 × 10−11 10.84 Hydrogenarsenate ion HAsO4 2− AsO4 3− 5.1 × 10−12 11.29 Hydrogenphosphate ion HPO4 2− PO4 3− 4.8 × 10−13 12.32 Hydrogensulfide ion HS− S2− 1.0 × 10−19 19.00 * At 293 K. 1008 DATA SECTION Table 7.4 Acidity constants for aqueous solutions at 298 K. (b) In alphabetical order Acid HA A− Ka pKa Acetic (ethanoic) CH3COOH CH3CO2 − 1.4 × 10−5 4.76 Ammonium ion NH4 + NH3 5.6 × 10−10 9.25 Anilinium ion C6H5NH3 + C6H5NH2 1.3 × 10−5 4.87 Boric* B(OH)3 B(OH)4 − 5.4 × 10−10 9.27 Butanoic CH3CH2CH2COOH CH3CH2CH2CO2 − 1.5 × 10−5 4.83 Carbonic H2CO3 HCO3 − 4.5 × 10−7 6.35 Diethylammonium ion (CH3CH2)2NH2 + (CH3CH2)2NH 1.4 × 10−11 10.84 Dihydrogenphosphate ion H2PO4 − HPO4 2− 6.2 × 10−8 7.21 Dimethylammonium ion (CH3)2NH2 + (CH3)2NH 1.9 × 10−11 10.73 Ethylammonium ion CH3CH2NH3 + CH3CH2NH2 2.2 × 10−11 10.65 Formic HCOOH HCO2 − 1.8 × 10−4 3.75 Glycinium ion + NH3CH2COOH NH2CH2COOH 4.5 × 10−3 2.35 Hydrazinium ion NH2NH3 + NH2NH2 8 × 10−9 8.1 Hydriodic HI I− 1011 −11 Hydrobromic HBr Br− 109 −9 Hydrochloric HCl Cl− 107 −7 Hydrocyanic HCN CN− 6.2 × 10−10 9.21 Hydrofluoric HF F− 6.3 × 10−4 3.20 Hydrogenarsenate ion HAsO4 2− AsO4 3− 5.1 × 10−12 11.29 Hydrogencarbonate ion HCO3 − CO3 2− 4.8 × 10−11 10.33 Hydrogenoxalate ion HOOCCO2 − C2O4 2− 1.5 × 10−5 3.81 Hydrogenphosphate ion HPO4 2− PO4 3− 4.8 × 10−13 12.32 Hydrogensulfate ion HSO4 − SO4 2− 1.0 × 10−2 1.99 Hydrogensulfide ion HS− S2− 1.0 × 10−19 19.00 Hydronium ion H3O+ H2O 1 0.0 Hydrosulfuric H2S HS− 8.9 × 10−8 7.05 Hypobromous HBrO BrO− 2.8 × 10−9 8.55 Hypochlorous HClO ClO− 4.0 × 10−8 7.40 Hypoiodous HIO IO− 3 × 10−11 10.5 Lactic CH3CH(OH)COOH CH3CH(OH)CO2 − 1.4 × 10−4 3.86 Methylammonium ion CH3NH3 + CH3NH2 2.2 × 10−11 10.66 Oxalic (COOH)2 HOOCCO2 − 5.6 × 10−2 1.25 Perchloric* HClO4 ClO4 − 4.0 × 101 −1.6 Phenol C6H5OH C6H5O− 1.0 × 10−10 9.99 Phosphoric H3PO4 H2PO4 − 6.9 × 10−3 2.16 Propanoic CH3CH2COOH CH3CH2CO2 − 1.4 × 10−5 4.87 Pyridinim ion C5H5NH+ C6H5N 5.9 × 10−6 5.23 Sulfuric H2SO4 HSO4 − 102 −2 Sulfurous H2SO3 HSO3 − 1.4 × 10−2 1.85 Triethylammonium ion (CH3CH2)3NH+ (CH3CH2)3N 1.8 × 10−11 10.75 Trimethylammonium ion (CH3)3NH+ (CH3)3N 1.6 × 10−10 9.80 * At 293 K. DATA SECTION 1009 Table 9.2 The error function z erf z z erf z 0 0 0.45 0.475 48 0.01 0.011 28 0.50 0.520 50 0.02 0.022 56 0.55 0.563 32 0.03 0.033 84 0.60 0.603 86 0.04 0.045 11 0.65 0.642 03 0.05 0.056 37 0.70 0.677 80 0.06 0.067 62 0.75 0.711 16 0.07 0.078 86 0.80 0.742 10 0.08 0.090 08 0.85 0.770 67 0.09 0.101 28 0.90 0.796 91 0.10 0.112 46 0.95 0.820 89 0.15 0.168 00 1.00 0.842 70 0.20 0.222 70 1.20 0.910 31 0.25 0.276 32 1.40 0.952 28 0.30 0.328 63 1.60 0.976 35 0.35 0.379 38 1.80 0.989 09 0.40 0.428 39 2.00 0.995 32 Data: AS. Table 10.2 Screening constants for atoms; values of Zeff = Z − σ for neutral ground-state atoms H He 1s 1 1.6875 Li Be B C N O F Ne 1s 2.6906 3.6848 4.6795 5.6727 6.6651 7.6579 8.6501 9.6421 2s 1.2792 1.9120 2.5762 3.2166 3.8474 4.4916 5.1276 5.7584 2p 2.4214 3.1358 3.8340 4.4532 5.1000 5.7584 Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar 1s 10.6259 11.6089 12.5910 13.5745 14.5578 15.5409 16.5239 17.5075 2s 6.5714 7.3920 8.3736 9.0200 9.8250 10.6288 11.4304 12.2304 2p 6.8018 7.8258 8.9634 9.9450 10.9612 11.9770 12.9932 14.0082 3s 2.5074 3.3075 4.1172 4.9032 5.6418 6.3669 7.0683 7.7568 3p 4.0656 4.2852 4.8864 5.4819 6.1161 6.7641 Data: E. Clementi and D.L. Raimondi, Atomic screening constants from SCF functions. IBM Res. Note NJ-27 (1963). J. chem. Phys. 38, 2686 (1963). 1010 DATA SECTION Table 10.4 Electron affinities, Eea/(kJ mol−1 ) H He 72.8 −21 Li Be B C N O F Ne 59.8 ≤0 23 122.5 −7 141 322 −29 −844 Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar 52.9 ≤0 44 133.6 71.7 200.4 348.7 −35 −532 K Ca Ga Ge As Se Br Kr 48.3 2.37 36 116 77 195.0 324.5 −39 Rb Sr In Sn Sb Te I Xe 46.9 5.03 34 121 101 190.2 295.3 −41 Cs Ba Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn 45.5 13.95 30 35.2 101 186 270 −41 Data: E. Table 10.3 Ionization energies, I/(kJ mol−1 ) H He 1312.0 2372.3 5250.4 Li Be B C N O F Ne 513.3 899.4 800.6 1086.2 1402.3 1313.9 1681 2080.6 7298.0 1757.1 2427 2352 2856.1 3388.2 3374 3952.2 Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar 495.8 737.7 577.4 786.5 1011.7 999.6 1251.1 1520.4 4562.4 1450.7 1816.6 1577.1 1903.2 2251 2297 2665.2 2744.6 2912 K Ca Ga Ge As Se Br Kr 418.8 589.7 578.8 762.1 947.0 940.9 1139.9 1350.7 3051.4 1145 1979 1537 1798 2044 2104 2350 2963 2735 Rb Sr In Sn Sb Te I Xe 403.0 549.5 558.3 708.6 833.7 869.2 1008.4 1170.4 2632 1064.2 1820.6 1411.8 1794 1795 1845.9 2046 2704 2943.0 2443 Cs Ba Tl Pb Bi Po At Rn 375.5 502.8 589.3 715.5 703.2 812 930 1037 2420 965.1 1971.0 1450.4 1610 2878 3081.5 2466 Data: E. DATA SECTION 1011 Table 11.2 Bond lengths, Re/pm (a) Bond lengths in specific molecules Br2 228.3 Cl2 198.75 CO 112.81 F2 141.78 H2 + 106 H2 74.138 HBr 141.44 HCl 127.45 HF 91.680 HI 160.92 N2 109.76 O2 120.75 (b) Mean bond lengths from covalent radii* H 37 C 77(1) N 74(1) O 66(1) F 64 67(2) 65(2) 57(2) 60(3) Si 118 P 110 S 104(1) Cl 99 95(2) Ge 122 As 121 Se 104 Br 114 Sb 141 Te 137 I 133 * Values are for single bonds except where indicated otherwise (values in parentheses). The length of an A-B covalent bond (of given order) is the sum of the corresponding covalent radii. Table 11.3a Bond dissociation enthalpies, ∆H7 (A-B)/(kJ mol−1 ) at 298 K Diatomic molecules H-H 436 F-F 155 Cl-Cl 242 Br-Br 193 I-I 151 O=O 497 C=O 1076 N.N 945 H-O 428 H-F 565 H-Cl 431 H-Br 366 H-I 299 Polyatomic molecules H-CH3 435 H-NH2 460 H-OH 492 H-C6H5 469 H3C-CH3 368 H2C=CH2 720 HC.CH 962 HO-CH3 377 Cl-CH3 352 Br-CH3 293 I-CH3 237 O=CO 531 HO-OH 213 O2N-NO2 54 Data: HCP, KL. 1012 DATA SECTION Table 11.4 Pauling (italics) and Mulliken electronegativities H He 2.20 3.06 Li Be B C N O F Ne 0.98 1.57 2.04 2.55 3.04 3.44 3.98 1.28 1.99 1.83 2.67 3.08 3.22 4.43 4.60 Na Mg Al Si P S Cl Ar 0.93 1.31 1.61 1.90 2.19 2.58 3.16 1.21 1.63 1.37 2.03 2.39 2.65 3.54 3.36 K Ca Ga Ge As Se Br Kr 0.82 1.00 1.81 2.01 2.18 2.55 2.96 3.0 1.03 1.30 1.34 1.95 2.26 2.51 3.24 2.98 Rb Sr In Sn Sb Te I Xe 0.82 0.95 1.78 1.96 2.05 2.10 2.66 2.6 0.99 1.21 1.30 1.83 2.06 2.34 2.88 2.59 Cs Ba Tl Pb Bi 0.79 0.89 2.04 2.33 2.02 Data: Pauling values: A.L. Allred, J. Inorg. Nucl. Chem. 17, 215 (1961); L.C. Allen and J.E. Huheey, ibid., 42, 1523 (1980). Mulliken values: L.C. Allen, J. Am. Chem. Soc. 111, 9003 (1989). The Mulliken values have been scaled to the range of the Pauling values. Table 11.3b Mean bond enthalpies, ∆H7 (A-B)/(kJ mol−1 ) H C N O F Cl Br I S P Si H 436 C 412 348(i) 612(ii) 838(iii) 518(a) N 388 305(i) 163(i) 613(ii) 409(ii) 890(iii) 946(iii) O 463 360(i) 157 146(i) 743(ii) 497(ii) F 565 484 270 185 155 Cl 431 338 200 203 254 242 Br 366 276 219 193 I 299 238 210 178 151 S 338 259 496 250 212 264 P 322 201 Si 318 374 466 226 (i) Single bond, (ii) double bond, (iii) triple bond, (a) aromatic. Data: HCP and L. Pauling, The nature of the chemical bond. Cornell University Press (1960). DATA SECTION 1013 Table 13.2 Properties of diatomic molecules §0/cm−1 qV/K B/cm−1 qR /K r/pm k/(N m−1 ) D/(kJ mol−1 ) s 1 H2 + 2321.8 3341 29.8 42.9 106 160 255.8 2 1 H2 4400.39 6332 60.864 87.6 74.138 574.9 432.1 2 2 H2 3118.46 4487 30.442 43.8 74.154 577.0 439.6 2 1 H19 F 4138.32 5955 20.956 30.2 91.680 965.7 564.4 1 1 H35 Cl 2990.95 4304 10.593 15.2 127.45 516.3 427.7 1 1 H81 Br 2648.98 3812 8.465 12.2 141.44 411.5 362.7 1 1 H127 I 2308.09 3321 6.511 9.37 160.92 313.8 294.9 1 14 N2 2358.07 3393 1.9987 2.88 109.76 2293.8 941.7 2 16 O2 1580.36 2274 1.4457 2.08 120.75 1176.8 493.5 2 19 F2 891.8 1283 0.8828 1.27 141.78 445.1 154.4 2 35 Cl2 559.71 805 0.2441 0.351 198.75 322.7 239.3 2 12 C16 O 2170.21 3122 1.9313 2.78 112.81 1903.17 1071.8 1 79 Br81 Br 323.2 465 0.0809 10.116 283.3 245.9 190.2 1 Data: AIP. Table 13.3 Typical vibrational wavenumbers, #/cm−1 C-H stretch 2850–2960 C-H bend 1340–1465 C-C stretch, bend 700–1250 C=C stretch 1620 –1680 C.C stretch 2100–2260 O-H stretch 3590–3650 H-bonds 3200–3570 C=O stretch 1640–1780 C.N stretch 2215–2275 N-H stretch 3200–3500 C-F stretch 1000–1400 C-Cl stretch 600–800 C-Br stretch 500–600 C-I stretch 500 CO3 2− 1410–1450 NO3 − 1350–1420 NO2 − 1230–1250 SO4 2− 1080–1130 Silicates 900–1100 Data: L.J. Bellamy, The infrared spectra of complex molecules and Advances in infrared group frequencies. Chapman and Hall. Table 14.1 Colour, frequency, and energy of light Colour l/nm n/(1014 Hz) §/(104 cm−1 ) E/eV E/(kJ mol−1 ) Infrared >1000 <3.00 <1.00 <1.24 <120 Red 700 4.28 1.43 1.77 171 Orange 620 4.84 1.61 2.00 193 Yellow 580 5.17 1.72 2.14 206 Green 530 5.66 1.89 2.34 226 Blue 470 6.38 2.13 2.64 254 Violet 420 7.14 2.38 2.95 285 Near ultraviolet 300 10.0 3.33 4.15 400 Far ultraviolet <200 >15.0 >5.00 >6.20 >598 Data: J.G. Calvert and J.N. Pitts, Photochemistry. Wiley, New York (1966). 1014 DATA SECTION Table 15.2 Nuclear spin properties Nuclide Natural Spin I Magnetic g-value g/(107 T−1 s−1 ) NMR frequency at abundance % moment m/mN 1 T, n/MHz 1 n* 1 –2 −1.9130 −3.8260 −18.324 29.164 1 H 99.9844 1 –2 2.792 85 5.5857 26.752 42.576 2 H 0.0156 1 0.857 44 0.857 45 4.1067 6.536 3 H* 1 –2 2.978 96 −4.2553 −20.380 45.414 10 B 19.6 3 1.8006 0.6002 2.875 4.575 11 B 80.4 3 –2 2.6886 1.7923 8.5841 13.663 13 C 1.108 1 –2 0.7024 1.4046 6.7272 10.708 14 N 99.635 1 0.403 76 0.403 56 1.9328 3.078 17 O 0.037 5 –2 −1.893 79 −0.7572 −3.627 5.774 19 F 100 1 –2 2.628 87 5.2567 25.177 40.077 31 P 100 1 –2 1.1316 2.2634 10.840 17.251 33 S 0.74 3 –2 0.6438 0.4289 2.054 3.272 35 Cl 75.4 3 –2 0.8219 0.5479 2.624 4.176 37 Cl 24.6 3 –2 0.6841 0.4561 2.184 3.476 * Radioactive. µ is the magnetic moment of the spin state with the largest value of mI: µ = gI µNI and µN is the nuclear magneton (see inside front cover). Data: KL and HCP. Table 14.3 Absorption characteristics of some groups and molecules Group §max /(104 cm−1 ) lmax/nm emax/(dm3 mol−1 cm−1 ) C=C (π* ← π) 6.10 163 1.5 × 104 5.73 174 5.5 × 103 C=O (π*← n) 3.7–3.5 270–290 10–20 -N=N- 2.9 350 15 >3.9 <260 Strong -NO2 3.6 280 10 4.8 210 1.0 × 104 C6H5- 3.9 255 200 5.0 200 6.3 × 103 5.5 180 1.0 × 105 [Cu(OH2)6]2+ (aq) 1.2 810 10 [Cu(NH3)4]2+ (aq) 1.7 600 50 H2O (π* ← n) 6.0 167 7.0 × 103 DATA SECTION 1015 Table 15.3 Hyperfine coupling constants for atoms, a/mT Nuclide Spin Isotropic Anisotropic coupling coupling 1 H 1 –2 50.8(1s) 2 H 1 7.8(1s) 13 C 1 –2 113.0(2s) 6.6(2p) 14 N 1 55.2(2s) 4.8(2p) 19 F 1 –2 1720(2s) 108.4(2p) 31 P 1 –2 364(3s) 20.6(3p) 35 Cl 3 –2 168(3s) 10.0(3p) 37 Cl 3 –2 140(3s) 8.4(3p) Data: P.W. Atkins and M.C.R. Symons, The structure of inorganic radicals. Elsevier, Amsterdam (1967). Table 18.1 Dipole moments, polarizabilities, and polarizability volumes m/(10−30 C m) m/D a/(10−40 J−1 C2 m2 ) a′/(10−30 m3 ) Ar 0 0 1.66 1.85 C2H5OH 5.64 1.69 C6H5CH3 1.20 0.36 C6H6 0 0 10.4 11.6 CCl4 0 0 10.3 11.7 CH2Cl2 5.24 1.57 6.80 7.57 CH3Cl 6.24 1.87 4.53 5.04 CH3OH 5.70 1.71 3.23 3.59 CH4 0 0 2.60 2.89 CHCl3 3.37 1.01 8.50 9.46 CO 0.390 0.117 1.98 2.20 CO2 0 0 2.63 2.93 H2 0 0 0.819 0.911 H2O 6.17 1.85 1.48 1.65 HBr 2.67 0.80 3.61 4.01 HCl 3.60 1.08 2.63 2.93 He 0 0 0.20 0.22 HF 6.37 1.91 0.51 0.57 HI 1.40 0.42 5.45 6.06 N2 0 0 1.77 1.97 NH3 4.90 1.47 2.22 2.47 1,2-C6H4(CH3)2 2.07 0.62 Data: HCP and C.J.F. Böttcher and P. Bordewijk, Theory of electric polarization. Elsevier, Amsterdam (1978). 1016 DATA SECTION Table 18.4 Lennard-Jones (12,6)-potential parameters (e/k)/K r0/pm Ar 111.84 362.3 C2H2 209.11 463.5 C2H4 200.78 458.9 C2H6 216.12 478.2 C6H6 377.46 617.4 CCl4 378.86 624.1 Cl2 296.27 448.5 CO2 201.71 444.4 F2 104.29 357.1 Kr 154.87 389.5 N2 91.85 391.9 O2 113.27 365.4 Xe 213.96 426.0 Source: F. Cuadros, I. Cachadiña, and W. Ahamuda, Molec. Engineering, 6, 319 (1996). Table 18.5 Surface tensions of liquids at 293 K g/(mN m−1 ) Benzene 28.88 Carbon tetrachloride 27.0 Ethanol 22.8 Hexane 18.4 Mercury 472 Methanol 22.6 Water 72.75 72.0 at 25°C 58.0 at 100°C Data: KL. Table 19.2 Diffusion coefficients of macromolecules in water at 20°C M/(kg mol−1 ) D/(10−10 m2 s−1 ) Sucrose 0.342 4.586 Ribonuclease 13.7 1.19 Lysozyme 14.1 1.04 Serum albumin 65 0.594 Haemoglobin 68 0.69 Urease 480 0.346 Collagen 345 0.069 Myosin 493 0.116 Data: C. Tanford, Physical chemistry of macromolecules. Wiley, New York (1961). Table 19.1 Radius of gyration of some macromolecules M/(kg mol−1 ) Rg/nm Serum albumin 66 2.98 Myosin 493 46.8 Polystyrene 3.2 × 103 50 (in poor solvent) DNA 4 × 103 117.0 Tobacco mosaic virus 3.9 × 104 92.4 Data: C. Tanford, Physical chemistry of macromolecules. Wiley, New York (1961). DATA SECTION 1017 Table 19.4 Intrinsic viscosity Macromolecule Solvent q/°C K/(10−3 cm3 g−1 ) a Polystyrene Benzene 25 9.5 0.74 Cyclohexane 34† 81 0.50 Polyisobutylene Benzene 23† 83 0.50 Cyclohexane 30 26 0.70 Amylose 0.33 m KCl(aq) 25† 113 0.50 Various Guanidine 7.16 0.66 proteins‡ hydrochloride + HSCH2CH2OH † The θ temperature. ‡ Use [η] = KNa ; N is the number of amino acid residues. Data: K.E. Van Holde, Physical biochemistry. Prentice-Hall, Englewood Cliffs (1971). Table 20.3 Ionic radii (r/pm)† Li+ (4) Be2+ (4) B3+ (4) N3− O2− (6) F− (6) 59 27 12 171 140 133 Na+ (6) Mg2+ (6) Al3+ (6) P3− S2− (6) Cl− (6) 102 72 53 212 184 181 K+ (6) Ca2+ (6) Ga3+ (6) As3− (6) Se2− (6) Br− (6) 138 100 62 222 198 196 Rb+ (6) Sr2+ (6) In3+ (6) Te2− (6) I− (6) 149 116 79 221 220 Cs+ (6) Ba2+ (6) Tl3+ (6) 167 136 88 d-block elements (high-spin ions) Sc3+ (6) Ti4+ (6) Cr3+ (6) Mn3+ (6) Fe2+ (6) Co3+ (6) Cu2+ (6) Zn2+ (6) 73 60 61 65 63 61 73 75 † Numbers in parentheses are the coordination numbers of the ions. Values for ions without a coordination number stated are estimates. Data: R.D. Shannon and C.T. Prewitt, Acta Cryst. B25, 925 (1969). Table 19.3 Frictional coefficients and molecular geometry Major axis/Minor axis Prolate Oblate 2 1.04 1.04 3 1.11 1.10 4 1.18 1.17 5 1.25 1.22 6 1.31 1.28 7 1.38 1.33 8 1.43 1.37 9 1.49 1.42 10 1.54 1.46 50 2.95 2.38 100 4.07 2.97 Data: K.E. Van Holde, Physical biochemistry. Prentice-Hall, Englewood Cliffs (1971). Sphere; radius a, c = af0 Prolate ellipsoid; major axis 2a, minor axis 2b, c = (ab2 )1/3 f = f0 Oblate ellipsoid; major axis 2a, minor axis 2b, c = (a2 b)1/3 f = f0 Long rod; length l, radius a, c = (3a2 /4)1/3 f = f0 In each case f0 = 6πηc with the appropriate value of c. 5 6 7 (1/2a)2/3 (3/2)1/3 {2 ln(l/a)− 0.11} 1 2 3 5 6 7 (a2 /b2 − 1)1/2 (a/b)2/3 arctan[(a2 /b2 − 1)1/2 ] 1 2 3 5 6 7 (1 − b2 /a2 )1/2 (b/a)2/3 ln{[1 + (1 − b2 /a2 )1/2 ]/(b/a)} 1 2 3 1018 DATA SECTION Table 20.5 Lattice enthalpies, ∆HL 7 /(kJ mol−1 ) F Cl Br I Halides Li 1037 852 815 761 Na 926 787 752 705 K 821 717 689 649 Rb 789 695 668 632 Cs 750 676 654 620 Ag 969 912 900 886 Be 3017 Mg 2524 Ca 2255 Sr 2153 Oxides MgO 3850 CaO 3461 SrO 3283 BaO 3114 Sulfides MgS 3406 CaS 3119 SrS 2974 BaS 2832 Entries refer to MX(s) → M+ (g) + X− (g). Data: Principally D. Cubicciotti, J. Chem. Phys. 31, 1646 (1959). Table 20.6 Magnetic susceptibilities at 298 K c/10−6 cm/(10−4 cm3 mol−1 ) Water −90 −16.0 Benzene −7.2 −6.4 Cyclohexane −7.9 −8.5 Carbon tetrachloride −8.9 −8.4 NaCl(s) −13.9 −3.75 Cu(s) −96 −6.8 S(s) −12.9 −2.0 Hg(l) −28.5 −4.2 CuSO4·5H2O(s) +176 +192 MnSO4·4H2O(s) +2640 +2.79 × 103 NiSO4·7H2O(s) +416 +600 FeSO4(NH4)2SO4·6H2O(s) +755 +1.51 × 103 Al(s) +22 +2.2 Pt(s) +262 +22.8 Na(s) +7.3 +1.7 K(s) +5.6 +2.5 Data: KL and χm = χM/ρ. Table 21.1 Collision cross-sections, σ/nm2 Ar 0.36 C2H4 0.64 C6H6 0.88 CH4 0.46 Cl2 0.93 CO2 0.52 H2 0.27 He 0.21 N2 0.43 Ne 0.24 O2 0.40 SO2 0.58 Data: KL. Table 21.2 Transport properties of gases at 1 atm k/(J K−1 m−1 s−1 ) h/mP 273 K 273 K 293 K Air 0.0241 173 182 Ar 0.0163 210 223 C2H4 0.0164 97 103 CH4 0.0302 103 110 Cl2 0.079 123 132 CO2 0.0145 136 147 H2 0.1682 84 88 He 0.1442 187 196 Kr 0.0087 234 250 N2 0.0240 166 176 Ne 0.0465 298 313 O2 0.0245 195 204 Xe 0.0052 212 228 Data: KL. DATA SECTION 1019 Table 21.6 Ionic mobilities in water at 298 K, u/(10−8 m2 s−1 V−1 ) Cations Anions Ag+ 6.24 Br− 8.09 Ca2+ 6.17 CH3CO2 − 4.24 Cu2+ 5.56 Cl− 7.91 H+ 36.23 CO3 2− 7.46 K+ 7.62 F− 5.70 Li+ 4.01 [Fe(CN)6]3− 10.5 Na+ 5.19 [Fe(CN)6]4− 11.4 NH4 + 7.63 I− 7.96 [N(CH3)4]+ 4.65 NO3 − 7.40 Rb+ 7.92 OH− 20.64 Zn2+ 5.47 SO4 2− 8.29 Data: Principally Table 21.4 and u = λ/zF. Table 21.7 Debye–Hückel–Onsager coefficients for (1,1)electrolytes at 25°C Solvent A/(mS m2 mol−1 / B/(mol dm−3 )−1/2 (mol dm−3 )1/2 ) Acetone (propanone) 3.28 1.63 Acetonitrile 2.29 0.716 Ethanol 8.97 1.83 Methanol 15.61 0.923 Nitrobenzene 4.42 0.776 Nitromethane 111 0.708 Water 6.020 0.229 Data: J.O’M. Bockris and A.K.N. Reddy, Modern electrochemistry. Plenum, New York (1970). Table 21.5 Limiting ionic conductivities in water at 298 K, λ/(mS m2 mol−1 ) Cations Anions Ba2+ 12.72 Br− 7.81 Ca2+ 11.90 CH3CO2 − 4.09 Cs+ 7.72 Cl− 7.635 Cu2+ 10.72 ClO4 − 6.73 H+ 34.96 CO3 2− 13.86 K+ 7.350 (CO2)2 2− 14.82 Li+ 3.87 F− 5.54 Mg2+ 10.60 [Fe(CN)6]3− 30.27 Na+ 5.010 [Fe(CN)6]4− 44.20 [N(C2H5)4]+ 3.26 HCO2 − 5.46 [N(CH3)4]+ 4.49 I− 7.68 NH4 + 7.35 NO3 − 7.146 Rb+ 7.78 OH− 19.91 Sr2+ 11.89 SO4 2− 16.00 Zn2+ 10.56 Data: KL, RS. Table 21.4 Viscosities of liquids at 298 K, η/(10−3 kg m−1 s−1 ) Benzene 0.601 Carbon tetrachloride 0.880 Ethanol 1.06 Mercury 1.55 Methanol 0.553 Pentane 0.224 Sulfuric acid 27 Water† 0.891 † The viscosity of water over its entire liquid range is represented with less than 1 per cent error by the expression log(η20/η) = A/B, A = 1.370 23(t − 20) + 8.36 × 10−4 (t − 20)2 B = 109 + t t = θ/°C Convert kg m−1 s−1 to centipoise (cP) by multiplying by 103 (so η ≈ 1 cP for water). Data: AIP, KL. 1020 DATA SECTION Table 21.8 Diffusion coefficients at 25°C, D/(10−9 m2 s−1 ) Molecules in liquids Ions in water I2 in hexane 4.05 H2 in CCl4(l) 9.75 K+ 1.96 Br− 2.08 in benzene 2.13 N2 in CCl4(l) 3.42 H+ 9.31 Cl− 2.03 CCl4 in heptane 3.17 O2 in CCl4(l) 3.82 Li+ 1.03 F− 1.46 Glycine in water 1.055 Ar in CCl4(l) 3.63 Na+ 1.33 I− 2.05 Dextrose in water 0.673 CH4 in CCl4(l) 2.89 OH− 5.03 Sucrose in water 0.5216 H2O in water 2.26 CH3OH in water 1.58 C2H5OH in water 1.24 Data: AIP and (for the ions) λ = zuF in conjunction with Table 21.5. Table 22.1 Kinetic data for first-order reactions Phase q/°C k/s−1 t1/2 2 N2O5 → 4 NO2 + O2 g 25 3.38 × 10−5 5.70 h HNO3(l) 25 1.47 × 10−6 131 h Br2(l) 25 4.27 × 10−5 4.51 h C2H6 → 2 CH3 g 700 5.36 × 10−4 21.6 min Cyclopropane → propene g 500 6.71 × 10−4 17.2 min CH3N2CH3 → C2H6 + N2 g 327 3.4 × 10−4 34 min Sucrose → glucose + fructose aq(H+ ) 25 6.0 × 10−5 3.2 h g: High pressure gas-phase limit. Data: Principally K.J. Laidler, Chemical kinetics. Harper & Row, New York (1987); M.J. Pilling and P.W. Seakins, Reaction kinetics. Oxford University Press (1995); J. Nicholas, Chemical kinetics. Harper & Row, New York (1976). See also JL. Table 22.2 Kinetic data for second-order reactions Phase q/°C k/(dm3 mol−1 s−1 ) 2 NOBr → 2 NO + Br2 g 10 0.80 2 NO2 → 2 NO + O2 g 300 0.54 H2 + I2 → 2 HI g 400 2.42 × 10−2 D2 + HCl → DH + DCl g 600 0.141 2 I → I2 g 23 7 × 109 hexane 50 1.8 × 1010 CH3Cl + CH3O− methanol 20 2.29 × 10−6 CH3Br + CH3O− methanol 20 9.23 × 10−6 H+ + OH− → H2O water 25 1.35 × 1011 ice −10 8.6 × 1012 Data: Principally K.J. Laidler, Chemical kinetics. Harper & Row, New York (1987); M.J. Pilling and P.W. Seakins, Reaction kinetics. Oxford University Press (1995); J. Nicholas, Chemical kinetics. Harper & Row, New York (1976). DATA SECTION 1021 Table 22.4 Arrhenius parameters First-order reactions A/s−1 Ea/(kJ mol−1 ) Cyclopropane → propene 1.58 × 1015 272 CH3NC → CH3CN 3.98 × 1013 160 cis-CHD=CHD → trans-CHD=CHD 3.16 × 1012 256 Cyclobutane → 2 C2H4 3.98 × 1013 261 C2H5I → C2H4 + HI 2.51 × 1017 209 C2H6 → 2 CH3 2.51 × 107 384 2 N2O5 → 4 NO2 + O2 4.94 × 1013 103 N2O → N2 + O 7.94 × 1011 250 C2H5 → C2H4 + H 1.0 × 1013 167 Second-order, gas-phase A/(dm3 mol−1 s−1 ) Ea/(kJ mol−1 ) O + N2 → NO + N 1 × 1011 315 OH + H2 → H2O + H 8 × 1010 42 Cl + H2 → HCl + H 8 × 1010 23 2 CH3 → C2H6 2 × 1010 ca. 0 NO + Cl2 → NOCl + Cl 4.0 × 109 85 SO + O2 → SO2 + O 3 × 108 27 CH3 + C2H6 → CH4 + C2H5 2 × 108 44 C6H5 + H2 → C6H6 + H 1 × 108 ca. 25 Second-order, solution A/(dm3 mol−1 s−1 ) Ea/(kJ mol−1 ) C2H5ONa + CH3I in ethanol 2.42 × 1011 81.6 C2H5Br + OH− in water 4.30 × 1011 89.5 C2H5I + C2H5O− in ethanol 1.49 × 1011 86.6 CH3I + C2H5O− in ethanol 2.42 × 1011 81.6 C2H5Br + OH− in ethanol 4.30 × 1011 89.5 CO2 + OH− in water 1.5 × 1010 38 CH3I + S2O3 2− in water 2.19 × 1012 78.7 Sucrose + H2O in acidic water 1.50 × 1015 107.9 (CH3)3CCl solvolysis in water 7.1× 1016 100 in methanol 2.3× 1013 107 in ethanol 3.0× 1013 112 in acetic acid 4.3× 1013 111 in chloroform 1.4× 104 45 C6H5NH2 + C6H5COCH2Br in benzene 91 34 Data: Principally J. Nicholas, Chemical kinetics. Harper & Row, New York (1976) and A.A. Frost and R.G. Pearson, Kinetics and mechanism. Wiley, New York (1961). 1022 DATA SECTION Table 24.1 Arrhenius parameters for gas-phase reactions A/(dm3 mol−1 s−1 ) Ea/(kJ mol−1 ) P Experiment Theory 2 NOCl → 2 NO + Cl2 9.4 × 109 5.9 × 1010 102.0 0.16 2 NO2 → 2 NO + O2 2.0 × 109 4.0 × 1010 111.0 5.0 × 10−2 2 ClO → Cl2 + O2 6.3 × 107 2.5 × 1010 0.0 2.5 × 10−3 H2 + C2H4 → C2H6 1.24 × 106 7.4 × 1011 180 1.7 × 10−6 K + Br2 → KBr + Br 1.0 × 1012 2.1 × 1011 0.0 4.8 Data: Principally M.J. Pilling and P.W. Seakins, Reaction kinetics. Oxford University Press (1995). Table 24.2 Arrhenius parameters for reactions in solution. See Table 22.4 Table 25.1 Maximum observed enthalpies of physisorption, ∆adH 7 /(kJ mol−1 ) C2H2 −38 H2 −84 C2H4 −34 H2O −59 CH4 −21 N2 −21 Cl2 −36 NH3 −38 CO −25 O2 −21 CO2 −25 Data: D.O. Haywood and B.M.W. Trapnell, Chemisorption. Butterworth (1964). Table 25.2 Enthalpies of chemisorption, ∆adH7 /(kJ mol−1 ) Adsorbate Adsorbent (substrate) Ti Ta Nb W Cr Mo Mn Fe Co Ni Rh Pt H2 −188 −188 −167 −71 −134 −117 N2 −586 −293 O2 −720 −494 −293 CO −640 −192 −176 CO2 −682 −703 −552 −456 −339 −372 −222 −225 −146 −184 NH3 −301 −188 −155 C2H4 −577 −427 −427 −285 −243 −209 Data: D.O. Haywood and B.M.W. Trapnell, Chemisorption. Butterworth (1964). DATA SECTION 1023 Table 25.3 Activation energies of catalysed reactions Catalyst Ea/(kJ mol−1 ) 2 HI → H2 + I2 None 184 Au(s) 105 Pt(s) 59 2 NH3 → N2 + 3 H2 None 350 W(s) 162 2 N2O → 2 N2 + O2 None 245 Au(s) 121 Pt(s) 134 (C2H5)2O pyrolysis None 224 I2(g) 144 Data: G.C. Bond, Heterogeneous catalysis. Clarendon Press, Oxford (1986). Table 25.6 Exchange current densities and transfer coefficients at 298 K Reaction Electrode j0/(A cm−2 ) a 2 H+ + 2 e− → H2 Pt 7.9 × 10−4 Cu 1 × 10−6 Ni 6.3 × 10−6 0.58 Hg 7.9 × 10−13 0.50 Pb 5.0 × 10−12 Fe3+ + e− → Fe2+ Pt 2.5 × 10−3 0.58 Ce4+ + e− → Ce3+ Pt 4.0 × 10−5 0.75 Data: Principally J.O’M. Bockris and A.K.N. Reddy, Modern electrochemistry. Plenum, New York (1970). Table A3.1 Refractive indices relative to air at 20°C 434 nm 589 nm 656 nm Benzene 1.5236 1.5012 1.4965 Carbon tetrachloride 1.4729 1.4676 1.4579 Carbon disulfide 1.6748 1.6276 1.6182 Ethanol 1.3700 1.3618 1.3605 KCl(s) 1.5050 1.4904 1.4973 Kl(s) 1.7035 1.6664 1.6581 Methanol 1.3362 1.3290 1.3277 Methylbenzene 1.5170 1.4955 1.4911 Water 1.3404 1.3330 1.3312 Data: AIP. C1 E h = 1 (1) A 1 Cs = Ch E σh h = 2 (m) A′ 1 1 x, y, Rz x2 , y2 , z2 , xy A″ 1 −1 z, Rx, Ry yz, xz Ci = S2 E i h = 2 (⁄) Ag 1 1 Rx, Ry, Rz x2 , y2 , z2 , xy, xz, yz Au 1 −1 x, y, z Character tables The groups C1, Cs, Ci 1024 DATA SECTION C4v, 4mm E C2 2C4 2σv 2σd h = 8 A1 1 1 1 1 1 z, z2 , x2 + y2 A2 1 1 1 −1 1 Rz B1 1 1 −1 1 −1 x2 − y2 B2 1 1 −1 −1 1 xy E 2 −2 0 0 0 (x, y), (xz, yz) (Rx, Ry) C5v E 2C5 2C5 2 5σv h = 10, a = 72° A1 1 1 1 1 z, z2 , x2 + y2 A2 1 1 1 −1 Rz E1 2 2 cos α 2 cos 2α 0 (x, y), (xz, yz) (Rx, Ry) E2 2 2 cos 2α 2 cos α 0 (xy, x2 − y2 ) C6v, 6mm E C2 2C3 2C6 3σd 3σv h = 12 A1 1 1 1 1 1 1 z, z2 , x2 + y2 A2 1 1 1 1 −1 1 Rz B1 1 −1 1 −1 −1 1 B2 1 −1 1 −1 1 −1 E1 2 −2 −1 1 0 0 (x, y), (xz, yz) (Rx, Ry) E2 2 2 −1 −1 0 0 (xy, x2 − y2 ) C2v, 2mm E C2 σv σ′v h = 4 A1 1 1 1 1 z, z2 , x2 , y2 A2 1 1 −1 −1 xy Rz B1 1 −1 1 −1 x, xz Ry B2 1 −1 −1 1 y, yz Rx C3v, 3m E 2C3 3σv h = 6 A1 1 1 1 z, z2 , x2 + y2 A2 1 1 −1 Rz E 2 −1 0 (x, y), (xy, x2 − y2 ) (xz, yz) (Rx, Ry) The groups Cnv DATA SECTION 1025 C•v E 2Cφ† •σv h = • A1(Σ+ ) 1 1 1 z, z2 , x2 + y2 A2(Σ− ) 1 1 −1 Rz E1(Π) 2 2 cos φ 0 (x, y), (xz, yz) (Rx, Ry) E2(∆) 2 2 cos 2φ 0 (xy, x2 − y2 ) † There is only one member of this class if φ = π. D4, 422 E C2 2C4 2C′2 2C2″ h = 8 A1 1 1 1 1 1 z2 , x2 + y2 A2 1 1 1 −1 −1 z Rz B1 1 1 −1 1 −1 x2 − y2 B2 1 1 −1 −1 1 xy E 2 −2 0 0 0 (x, y), (xz, yz) (Rx, Ry) D3, 32 E 2C3 3C′2 h = 6 A1 1 1 1 z2 , x2 + y2 A2 1 1 −1 z Rz E 2 −1 0 (x, y), (xz, yz), (xy, x2 − y2 ) (Rx, Ry) D2, 222 E C2 z C2 y C2 x h = 4 A1 1 1 1 1 x2 , y2 , z2 B1 1 1 −1 −1 z, xy Rz B2 1 −1 1 −1 y, xz Ry B3 1 −1 −1 1 x, yz Rx The groups Dn The groups Dnh D3h, %2m E σh 2C3 2S3 3C′2 3σv h = 12 A′1 1 1 1 1 1 1 z2 , x2 + y2 A′2 1 1 1 1 −1 −1 Rz A1″ 1 −1 1 −1 1 −1 A2″ 1 −1 1 −1 −1 1 z E′ 2 2 −1 −1 0 0 (x, y), (xy, x2 − y2 ) E″ 2 −2 −1 1 0 0 (xz, yz) (Rx, Ry) 1026 DATA SECTION D•h E 2Cf •C′2 i 2iC• iC′2 h = • A1g(Σg + ) 1 1 1 1 1 1 z2 , x2 + y2 A1u (Σu + ) 1 1 1 −1 −1 −1 z A2g(Σg − ) 1 1 −1 1 1 −1 Rz A2u(Σu − ) 1 1 −1 −1 1 1 E1g(Πg) 2 2 cos φ 0 2 −2 cos φ 0 (xz, yz) (Rx, Ry) E1u(Πu) 2 2 cos φ 0 −2 2 cos φ 0 (x, y) E2g(∆g) 2 2 cos 2φ 0 2 2 cos 2φ 0 (xy, x2 − y2 ) E2u(∆u) 2 2 cos 2φ 0 −2 −2 cos 2φ 0 Ӈ D5h E 2C5 2C5 2 5C2 σh 2S5 2S5 3 5σv h = 20 a = 72° A′1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 x2 + y2 , z2 A′2 1 1 1 −1 1 1 1 −1 Rz E′1 2 2 cos α 2 cos 2α 0 2 2 cos α 2 cos 2α 0 (x, y) E′2 2 2 cos 2α 2 cos α 0 2 2 cos 2α 2 cos α 0 (x2 − y2 , xy) A″1 1 1 1 1 −1 −1 −1 −1 A″2 1 1 1 −1 −1 −1 −1 1 z E″1 2 2 cos α 2 cos 2α 0 −2 −2 cos α −2 cos 2α 0 (xz, yz) (Rx, Ry) E″2 2 2 cos 2α 2 cos α 0 −2 −2 cos 2α −2 cos α 0 D4h, 4/mmm E 2C4 C2 2C′2 2C2″ i 2S4 σh 2σv 2σd h = 16 A1g 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 x2 + y2 , z2 A2g 1 1 1 −1 −1 1 1 1 −1 −1 Rz B1g 1 −1 1 1 −1 1 −1 1 1 −1 x2 − y2 B2g 1 −1 1 −1 1 1 −1 1 −1 1 xy Eg 2 0 −2 0 0 2 0 −2 0 0 (xz, yz) (Rx, Ry) A1u 1 1 1 1 1 −1 −1 −1 −1 −1 A2u 1 1 1 −1 −1 −1 −1 −1 1 1 z B1u 1 −1 1 1 −1 −1 1 −1 −1 1 B2u 1 −1 1 −1 1 −1 1 −1 1 −1 Eu 2 0 −2 0 0 −2 0 2 0 0 (x, y) DATA SECTION 1027 I E 12C5 12C5 2 20C3 15C2 h = 60 A 1 1 1 1 1 z2 + y2 + z2 T1 3 1 –2(1 + ) 1 –2(1 − ) 0 −1 (x, y, z) T2 3 1 –2(1 − ) 1 –2(1 + ) 0 −1 (Rx, Ry, Rz) G 4 −1 −1 1 0 G 5 0 0 −1 1 (2z2 − x2 − y2 , x2 − y2 , xy, yz, zx) Further information: P.W. Atkins, M.S. Child, and C.S.G. Phillips, Tables for group theory. Oxford University Press (1970). 55 55 Oh (m3m) E 8C3 6C2 6C2 3C2 (= C4 2 ) i 6S4 8S6 3σh 6σd h = 48 A1g 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 x2 + y2 + z2 A2g 1 1 −1 −1 1 1 −1 1 1 −1 Eg 2 −1 0 0 2 2 0 −1 2 0 (2z2 − x2 − y2 , x2 − y2 ) T1g 3 0 −1 1 −1 3 1 0 −1 −1 (Rx, Ry, Rz) T2g 3 0 1 −1 −1 3 −1 0 −1 1 (xy, yz, xy) A1u 1 1 1 1 1 −1 −1 −1 −1 −1 A2u 1 1 −1 −1 1 −1 1 −1 −1 1 Eu 2 −1 0 0 2 −2 0 1 −2 0 T1u 3 0 −1 1 −1 −3 −1 0 1 1 (x, y, z) T2u 3 0 1 −1 −1 −3 1 0 1 −1 Td, ∞3m E 8C3 3C2 6σd 6S4 h = 24 A1 1 1 1 1 1 x2 + y2 + z2 A2 1 1 1 −1 −1 E 2 −1 2 0 0 (3z2 − r2 , x2 − y2 ) T1 3 0 −1 −1 1 (Rx, Ry, Rz) T2 3 0 −1 1 −1 (x, y, z), (xy, xz, yz) The cubic groups The icosahedral group Chapter 1 1.1 (a) 10.5 bar, (b) 10.4 bar. 1.2 (a) 1.07 bar; (b) 803 Torr. 1.3 120 kPa. 1.4 2.67 × 103 kg. 1.5 1.5 × 103 Pa. 1.6 115 kPa. 1.7 R = 0.082 061 5 dm3 atm K−1 mol−1 ,M = 31.9987 g mol−1 . 1.8 P4. 1.9 2.61 kg. 1.10 (a) 3.14 dm3 ;(b) 28.2 kPa. 1.11 16.14 g mol−1 . 1.12 −270°C. 1.13 (a) (i) 1.0 atm, (ii) 270 atm. (b) (i) 0.99 atm, (ii) 190 atm. 11.4 a = 1.34 × 10−1 kg m5 s−2 mol−2 , b = 4.36 × 10−5 m3 mol−1 . 1.15 (a) 1.12, repulsive; (b) 2.7 dm3 mol−1 . 1.16 (a) 0.124 dm3 mol−1 ; (b) 0.112 dm3 mol−1 . 1.17 (a) 8.7 cm3 ; (b) −0.15 dm3 mol−1 . 1.18 (a) xN = 0.63, xH = 0.37; (b) pN = 2.5 atm, pH = 1.5 atm; (c) 4.0 atm. 1.19 b = 0.0493 dm3 mol−1 , r = 1.94 × 10−10 m, a = 3.16 dm6 atm mol−2 . 1.20 (a) 1259 K; (b) 0.129 nm. 1.21 (a) p = 2.6 atm, T = 881 K; (b) p = 2.2 atm, T = 718 K; (c) p = 1.4 atm, T = 356 K. 1.22 b = 1.3 × 10−4 m3 mol−1 , Z = 0.67. Chapter 2 2.1 59 J. 2.2 −91 J. 2.3 (a) ∆U = ∆H = 0, q = −w = 1.62 × 103 J; (b) ∆U = ∆H = 0, q = −w = 1.38 × 103 J; (c) ∆U = ∆H = 0, q = w = 0. 2.4 p2 = 143 kPa, w = 0, q = 3.28 × 103 J, ∆U = 3.28 × 103 J. 2.5 (a) −19 J; (b) −52.8 J. 2.6 ∆H = q = −70.6 kJ, w = 5.60 × 103 J, ∆U = −65.0 kJ. 2.7 −188 J. 2.8 (a) ∆H = q = 14.9 × 103 J, w = −831 J, ∆U = 14.1 kJ. (b) ∆H = 14.9 kJ, w = 0, ∆U = q = 14.1 kJ. 2.9 200 K. 2.10 −325 J. 2.11 8.5 Torr. 2.12 Cp,m = 53 J K−1 mol−1 , CV,m = 45 J K−1 mol−1 . 2.13 ∆H = q = 2.0 × 103 J mol−1 , ∆U = 1.6 × 103 J mol−1 . 2.14 q = 0, w = −3.5 × 103 J = ∆U, ∆T = −24 K, ∆H = −4.5 × 103 J. 2.15 Vf = 0.0205 m3 , Tf = 279 K, w = −6.7 × 102 J. 2.16 q = ∆H = 24.0 kJ, w = −1.6 kJ, ∆U = 22.4 kJ. 2.17 −3053.6 kJ mol−1 . Solutions to b) exercises 2.18 −1152 kJ mol−1 . 2.19 C = 68.3 J K−1 , ∆T = +64.1 K. 2.20 +84.40 kJ mol−1 . 2.21 +1.90 kJ mol−1 . 2.22 (a) ∆rH7 = −589.56 kJ mol−1 , ∆rU7 = −582.13 kJ mol−1 . (b) ∆fH7 (HI) = 26.48 kJ mol−1 , ∆fH7 (H2O) = −241.82 kJ mol−1 . 2.23 −760.3 kJ mol−1 . 2.24 +52.5 kJ mol−1 . 2.25 −566.93 kJ mol−1 . 2.26 (a) ∆rH7 (298 K) = −175 kJ mol−1 , ∆rU7 (298 K) = −173 kJ mol−1 ; (b) ∆rH7 (348 K) = −176 mol−1 . 2.27 −65.49 kJ mol−1 . 2.28 −1587 kJ mol−1 . 2.29 0.48 K atm−1 . 2.30 ∆Um = +129 J mol−1 , q = +7.7465 kJ mol−1 , w = −7.62 kJ mol−1 . 2.31 1.27 × 10−3 K−1 . 2.32 3.6 × 102 atm. 2.33 −41.2 J atm−1 mol−1 , q (supplied) = 27.2 × 103 J. Chapter 3 3.1 (a) 1.8 × 102 J K−1 ;(b) 1.5 × 102 J K−1 . 3.2 152.65 J K−1 mol−1 . 3.3 −7.3 J K−1 . 3.4 ∆S = q = 0, w = ∆U = +2.75 kJ, ∆H = +3.58 kJ. 3.5 ∆Htot = 0, ∆Stot = 24 J K−1 . 3.6 (a) 0; (b) −230 J; (c) −230 J; (d) −5.3 K; (e) 3.2 J K−1 . 3.7 (a) 104.6 J K−1 ; (b) −104.6 J K−1 . 3.8 (a) −21.0 J K−1 mol−1 ; (b) +512.0 J K−1 mol−1 . 3.9 (a) −212.40 kJ mol−1 ; (b) −5798 kJ mol−1 . 3.10 (a) −212.55 kJ mol−1 ; (b) −5798 kJ mol−1 . 3.11 −86.2 kJ mol−1 . 3.12 −197 kJ mol−1 . 3.13 (a) ∆S(gas) = +3.0 J K−1 , ∆S(surroundings) = −3.0 J K−1 , ∆S(total) = 0; (b) ∆S(gas) = +3.0 J K−1 , ∆S(surroundings) = 0; ∆S(total) = +3.0 J K−1 ; (c) ∆S(gas) = 0, ∆S(surroundings) = 0, ∆S(total) = 0. 3.14 2108.11 kJ mol−1 . 3.15 (a) 0.500; (b) 0.50 kJ; (c) 0.5 kJ. 3.16 −2.0 J. 3.17 −42.8 J K−1 . 3.18 3.0 kJ. 3.19 2.71 kJ mol−1 . 3.20 −0.93 kJ mol−1 . 3.21 200 J. 3.22 +2.88 kJ mol−1 . Chapter 4 4.1 296 K = 23°C. 4.2 ∆fusS = +5.5 J K−1 mol−1 ,∆fusH = +2.4 kJ mol−1 . 4.3 25.25 kJ mol−1 . 4.4 (a) 31.11 kJ mol−1 ; (b) 276.9 K. SOLUTIONS TO B) EXERCISES 1029 4.5 272 K. 4.6 3.6 kg s−1 . 4.7 Frost will sublime, 0.40 kPa or more. 4.8 (a) 29.1 kJ mol−1 ; (b) At 25°C, p1 = 0.22 atm = 168 Torr; At 60°C, p1 = 0.76 atm = 576 Torr. 4.9 272.41 K. 4.10 6.73 × 10−2 = 6.73 per cent. Chapter 5 5.1 843.5 cm3 . 5.2 18 cm3 . 5.3 8.2 × 103 kPa. 5.4 1.5 × 102 kPa. 5.5 270 g mol−1 . 5.6 178 g mol−1 . 5.7 −0.077°C. 5.8 ∆mixG = −17.3 J, ∆mixS = 6.34 × 10−2 J K−1 . 5.9 ∆mixG = −3.43 kJ, ∆mixS = +11.5 J K−1 , ∆mixH = 0. 5.10 (a) 1:1; (b) 0.7358. 5.11 N2: 0.51 mmol kg−1 , O2: 0.27 mmol kg−1 . 5.12 0.067 mol dm−3 . 5.13 11 kg. 5.14 14.0 kg mol−1 . 5.15 aA = 0.9701, xA = 0.980. 5.16 −3536 J mol−1 , 212 Torr. 5.17 aA = 0.436, aB = 0.755, γA = 1.98, γB = 0.968. 5.18 0.320. 5.19 (a) 45.0 kg KNO3; (b) 38.8 g Ba(NO3)2. 5.20 0.661. 5.21 1.3. Chapter 6 6.1 xA = 0.5, yB = 0.5. 6.2 xA = 0.653, xB = 0.347, p = 73.4 kPa. 6.3 (a) the solution is ideal; (b) yA = 0.4582, yB = 0.5418. 6.4 (a) 6.4 kPa; (b) yB = 0.77, yT = 0.23; (c) p(final) = 4.5 kPa. 6.5 (a) yA = 0.81; (b) xA = 0.67, yA = 0.925. 6.6 C = 3. 6.7 (a) C = 1, P = 2; (b) C = 2, P = 2. 6.8 (a) C = 2, P = 2; (b) F = 2. 6.11 xB = 0.53, T = T2, xB = 0.82, T = T3. 6.13 (a) xB ≈ 0.53; (b) xAB2 ≈ 0.8; (c) xAB2 ≈ 0.6. 6.14 A solid solution with x(ZrF4) = 0.24 appears at 855°C. The solid solution continues to form, and its ZrF4 content increases until it reaches x(ZrF4) = 0.40 and 820°C. At that temperature, the entire sample is solid. 6.17 (a) When xA falls to 0.47, a second liquid phase appears. The amount of new phase increases as xA falls and the amount of original phase decreases until, at xA = 0.314, only one liquid remains. (b) The mixture has a single liquid phase at all compositions. Chapter 7 7.1 (a) ∆rG = 0; (b) K = 0.16841; (c) ∆rG7 = 4.41 kJ mol−1 . 7.2 (a) K = 0.24; (b) ∆rG7 = 19 kJ mol−1 ; (c) K = 2.96. 7.3 (a) K = 1.3 × 1054 , ∆rG7 = 308.84 kJ mol−1 ; (b) K = 3.5 × 1049 , ∆rG7 = −306.52 kJ mol−1 . 7.4 (a) Mole fractions: A: 0.1782, B: 0.0302, C: 0.1162, 2D: 0.6742, Total: 0.9999; (b) Kx = 9.6; (c) K = 9.6; (d) ∆rG7 = −5.6 kJ mol−1 . 7.5 T2 = 1.4 × 103 K. 7.6 ∆rH7 = 7.191 kJ mol−1 ,∆rS7 = −21 J K−1 mol−1 . 7.7 ∆G7 = −41.0 kJ mol−1 . 7.9 xNO = 1.6 × 10−2 . 7.10 (a) ∆fH7 = 39 kJ mol−1 ; (b) ∆fH7 = −39 kJ mol−1 . 7.11 (a) At 427°C, K = 9.24, At 459°C, K = 31.08; (b) ∆rG7 = −12.9 kJ mol−1 ; (c) ∆rH7 = +161 kJ mol−1 ; (d) ∆rS7 = +248 J K−1 mol−1 . 7.12 T = 397 K. 7.13 ∆fG7 = −128.8 kJ mol−1 . 7.14 (a) R: Ag2CrO4(s) + 2e− → 2Ag(s) + CrO4 2− (aq) +0.45 V L: Cl2(g) + 2e− → 2Cl− (aq) +1.36 V Overall (R – L): Ag2CrO4(s) + 2Cl− (aq) → 2Ag(s) + CrO4 2− (aq) + Cl2(g) −0.91 V (b) R: Sn4+ (aq) + 2e− → Sn2+ (aq) + 0.15 V L: 2Fe3+ (aq) + 2e− → 2Fe2+ (aq) + 0.77 V Overall (R – L): Sn4+ (aq) + 2Fe2+ (aq) → Sn2+ (aq) + 2Fe3+ (aq) −0.62 V (c) R: MnO2(s) + 4H+ (aq) + 2e− → Mn2+ (aq) + 2Fe3+ (aq) +1.23 V L: Cu2+ (aq) + 2e− → Cu(s) +0.34 V Overall (R – L): Cu(s) + MnO2(s) + 4H+ (aq) → Cu2+ (aq) + Mn2+ (aq) + 2H2O(l) +0.89 V 7.15 (a) R: 2H2O(1) + 2e− → 2OH− (aq) + H2(g) −0.83 V L: 2Na+ (aq) + 2e− → 2Na(s) −2.71 V and the cell is Na(s)|Na+ (aq), OH− (aq)|H2(g)Pt +1.88 V (b) R: I2(s) + 2e− → 2I− (aq) +0.54 V L: 2H+ (aq) + 2e− → H2(g) 0.00 V and the cell is Pt|H2(g)|H+ (aq), I− (aq)|I2(s)|Pt +0.54 V (c) R: 2H+ (aq) + 2e− → H2(g) 0.00 V L: 2H2O(1) + 2e− → H2(g) + 2OH− (aq) 0.083 V and the cell is Pt|H2(g)|H+ (aq), OH− (aq)|H2(g)|Pt 0.083 V 7.16 (a) E = E7 − ln(γ±b); (b) ∆rG7 = −89.89 kJ mol−1 ; (c) E7 = +0.223 V. 7.17 (a) K = 1.7 × 1016 ; (b) K = 8.2 × 10−7 . 7.18 (a) 1.4 × 10−20 ; (b) 5.2 × 10−98 . Chapter 8 8.1 ν = 1.3 × 10−5 m s−1 . 8.2 p = 1.89 × 10−27 kg m s−1 , ν = 0.565 m s−1 . 8.3 ∆x = 5.8 × 10−6 m. 8.4 (a) E = 0.93 × 10−19 J, E (per mole) = 598 kJ mol−1 ; (b) E = 1.32 × 10−15 J, E (per mole) = 7.98 × 105 kJ mol−1 ; (c) E = 1.99 × 10−23 J, E (per mole) = 0.012 kJ mol−1 . 8.5 (a) ν = 0.499 m s−1 ; (b) ν = 665 m s−1 ; (c) ν = 9.98 × 10−6 m s−1 . 8.6 ν = 158 m s−1 . 8.7 (a) 3.52 × 1017 s−1 ; (b) 3.52 × 1018 s−1 . 8.8 (a) 0; (b) EK = 6.84 × 10−19 J; ν = 1.23 × 106 m s−1 . 8.9 (a) E = 2.65 × 10−19 J, or 160 kJ mol−1 ; (b) E = 3.00 × 10−19 J, or 181 kJ mol−1 ; (c) E = 6.62 × 10−31 J, or 4.0 × 10−10 kJ mol−1 . 8.10 (a) λ = 1.23 × 10−10 m; (b) λ = 3.9 × 10−11 m; (c) λ = 3.88 × 10−1 m. 8.12 ∆x = 100 pm, speed (∆ν): 5.8 × 105 m s−1 . 2RT F 1030 SOLUTIONS TO B) EXERCISES 8.13 1.67 × 10−16 J. 8.14 $. Chapter 9 9.1 (a) 2.14 × 10−19 J, 1.34 eV, 1.08 × 104 cm−1 , 129 kJ mol−1 ; (b) 3.48 × 10−19 J, 2.17 eV, 1.75 × 104 cm−1 , 210 kJ mol−1 . 9.2 (a) P = 0.031; (b) P = 0.029. 9.3 p = 0, p2 = . 9.4 L = 1/2 = 1/2 λc. 9.5 x = , , , , . 9.6 6. 9.7 n = 7.26 × 1010 , ∆E = 1.71 × 10−31 J, m = 27.5 pm, the particle behaves classically. 9.8 E0 = 3.92 × 10−21 J. 9.9 k = 260 N m−1 . 9.10 λ = 13.2 µm. 9.11 λ = 18.7 µm. 9.12 (a) ∆E = 2.2 × 10−29 J; (b) ∆E = 3.14 × 10−20 J. 9.14 0, ±0.96α, or ±2.02α. 9.15 E0 = 2.3421 × 10−20 J. 9.17 Magnitude = 2.58 × 10−34 J s; possible projections = 0, ±1.0546 × 10−34 J s and ±2.1109 × 10−34 J s. Chapter 10 10.1 I = 12.1 eV. 10.2 r = 11.5a0/Z, r = 3.53a0/Z, r = 0. 10.3 r = 0, r = 1.382a0, r = 3.618a0. 10.4 . 10.5 ͗V͘ = − , ͗EK͘ = . 10.6 P3s = 4πr2 × × 3 × (6 − 6ρ + ρ2 )2 e−ρ , r = 0.74 a0/Z, 4.19 a0/Z and 13.08 a0/Z. 10.7 r = 1.76 a0/Z. 10.8 (a) angular momentum = 61 –2h = 2.45 × 10−34 J s, angular nodes = 2, radial nodes = 1; (b) angular momentum = 21 –2h = 1.49 × 10−34 J s, angular nodes = 1, radial nodes = 0; (c) angular momentum = 21 –2h = 1.49 × 10−34 J s, angular nodes = 1, radial nodes = 1. 10.9 (a) j = 1 –2,3 –2; (b) j = 9 –2,11 ––2 . 10.10 J = 8,7,6,5,4,3,2. 10.11 (a) g = 1; (b) g = 64; (c) g = 25. 10.12 The letter F indicates that the total orbital angular momentum quantum number L is 3; the superscript 3 is the multiplicity of the term, 2S + 1, related to the spin quantum number S = 1; and the subscript 4 indicates the total angular momentum quantum number J. 10.13 (a) r = 110 pm, r = 20.1 ppm; (b) r = 86 pm, r = 29.4 pm. 10.14 (a) forbidden; (b) allowed; (c) forbidden. D E F Z α0 A B C D E F 1 243 A B C D E F 1 4π A B C $2 Z2 8ma0 2 Z2 e2 16πε0a0 N a = 1 4 2 0 3π 9L 10 7L 10 L 2 3L 10 L 10 D E F 3 8 A B C h mc D E F 3 8 A B C h2 L2 10.15 (a) [Ar]3d3 ; (b) For S = 3 –2, Ms = ±1 –2 and ±3 –2, for S = 1 –2, Ms = ± 1 –2. 10.16 (a) S = 2,1,0; multiplicities = 5,3,1, respectively. (b) S′ = 5 –2,3 –2,1 –2; multiplicities = 6,4,2 respectively. 10.17 1 F3; 3 F4; 3 F3; 3 F2; 1 D2; 3 D3; 3 D2; 3 D1; 1 P1; 3 P2; 3 P1; 3 P0, the 3 F2 set of terms are the lower in energy. 10.18 (a) J = 3, 2 and 1, with 7, 5 and 3 states respectively; (b) J = 7 –2,5 –2,3 –2,1 –2, with 8, 6, 4 and 2 states respectively; (c) J = 9 –2,7 –2, with 10 and 8 states respectively. 10.19 (a) 2 D5/2 and 2 D3/2 (b) 2 P3/2 and 2 P1/2. Chapter 11 11.1 (a) 1σ2 2σ*1 ; (b) 1σ2 2σ*2 1π4 3σ2 ; (c) 1σ2 2σ*2 3σ2 1π4 2π*2 . 11.2 (a) 1σ2 2σ*2 3σ2 1π4 2π*4 ; (b) 1σ2 2σ*2 1π4 3σ2 ; (c) 1σ2 2σ*2 3σ2 1π4 2π*3 . 11.3 (a) C2 and CN; (b) NO, O2 and F2. 11.4 BrCl is likely to have a shorter bond length than BrCl− ; it has a bond order of 1, while BrCl− has a bond order of 1/2. 11.5 The sequence O+ 2, O2, O− 2, O2 2− has progressively longer bonds. 11.6 N = 1/2 . 11.7 a = − b, N(0.844A − 0.145B). 11.8 Not appropriate. 11.9 Etrial = . 11.10 3.39 × 10−16 J. 11.12 (a) a2 2ue4 1ge1 2u, E = 7α + 7β; (b) a2 2ue3 1g, E = 5α + 7β. 11.13 (a) 19.31368β; (b) 19.44824β. Chapter 12 12.1 CCl4 has 4 C3 axes (each C-Cl axis), 3 C2 axes (bisecting Cl-C-Cl angles), 3 S4 axes (the same as the C2 axes), and 6 dihedral mirror planes (each Cl-C-Cl plane). 12.2 (a) CH3Cl. 12.3 Yes, it is zero. 12.4 Forbidden. 12.6 Td has S4 axes and mirror planes (= S1), Th has a centre of inversion (= S2). 12.8 (a) C∞V; (b) D3; (c) C4V, C2V; (d) Cs. 12.9 (a) D2h; (b) D2h; (c) (i) C2V; (ii) C2V; (iii) D2h. 12.10 (a) C∞V; (b) D5h; (c) C2V; (d) D3h; (e) Oh; (f) Td. 12.11 (a) ortho-dichlorobenzene, meta-dichlorobenzene, HF and XeO2F2; (b) none are chiral. 12.12 NO3 − :px and py, SO3: all d orbitals except dz 2 . 12.13 A2. 12.14 (a) B3U(x-polarized), B2U(y-polarized), B1U(z-polarized); (b) A1U or E1U. 12.15 Yes, it is zero. Chapter 13 13.1 (a) 7.73 × 10−32 J m−3 s; (b) ν = 6.2 × 10−28 J m−3 s. 13.2 s = 6.36 × 107 m s−1 . 13.3 (a) 1.59 ns; (b) 2.48 ps. −µe4 12π3 ε2 0$2 0.145S + 0.844 0.145 + 0.844S D E F 1 1 + 2λS + λ2 A B C SOLUTIONS TO B) EXERCISES 1031 13.4 (a) 160 MHz; (b) 16 MHz. 13.5 ν = 3.4754 × 1011 s−1 . 13.6 (a) I = 3.307 × 10−47 kg m2 ; (b) R = 141 pm. 13.7 (a) I = 5.420 × 10−46 kg m2 ; (b) R = 162.8 pm. 13.8 R = 116.21 pm. 13.9 RCO = 116.1 pm; RCS = 155.9 pm. 13.10 ÄStokes = 20 603 cm−1 . 13.11 R = 141.78 pm. 13.12 (a) H2O, C2V; (b) H2O2, C2; (c) NH3, C3V; (d) N2O, C∞V. 13.13 (a) CH2Cl2; (b) CH3CH3; (d) N2O. 13.14 k = 0.71 N m−1 . 13.15 28.4 per cent. 13.16 k = 245.9 N m−1 . 13.17 (a) 0.212; (b) 0.561. 13.18 DF: # = 3002.3 cm−1 , DCl: # = 2143.7 cm−1 , DBr: # = 1885.8 cm−1 , DI: # = 1640.1 cm−1 . 13.19 # = 2374.05 cm−1 , xe = 6.087 × 10−3 . 13.20 D0 = 3.235 × 104 cm−1 = 4.01 eV. 13.21 #R = 2347.16 cm−1 . 13.22 (a) CH3CH3; (b) CH4; (c) CH3Cl. 13.23 (a) 30; (b) 42; (c) 13. 13.24 (a) IR active = A2″ + E′, Raman active = A1 + E′; (b) IR active = A1 + E, Raman active = A1 + E. 13.25 (a) IR active; (b) Raman active. 13.26 A1g + A2g + E1u. Chapter 14 14.1 multiplicity = 3, parity = u. 14.2 22.2 per cent. 14.3 ε = 7.9 × 105 cm2 mol−1 . 14.4 1.33 × 10−3 mol dm−3 . 14.5 A = 1.56 × 108 dm3 mol−1 cm−2 . 14.6 Rise. 14.7 ε = 522 dm3 mol−1 cm−1 . 14.8 ε = 128 dm3 mol−1 cm−1 , T = 0.13. 14.9 (a) 0.010 cm; (b) 0.033 cm. 14.10 (a) 1.39 × 108 dm3 mol−1 cm−2 ; (b) 1.39 × 109 m mol−1 . 14.11 Stronger. Chapter 15 15.1 ν = 649 MHz. 15.2 EmI = −2.35 × 10−26 J, 0, +2.35 × 10−26 J. 15.3 47.3 MHz. 15.4 (a) ∆E = 2.88 × 10−26 J; (b) ∆E = 5.77 × 10−24 J. 15.5 3.523 T. 15.6 B/T 14 N 19 F 31 P gI 0.40356 5.2567 2.2634 (a) 300 MHz 97.5 7.49 17.4 (b) 750 MHz 244 18.7 43.5 15.7 (a) 4.3 × 10−7 ; (b) 2.2 × 10−6 ; (c) 1.34 × 10−5 . 15.8 (a) δ is independent of both B and v. (b) = 13. ν − ν°(800 MHz) ν − ν°(60 MHz) 15.9 (a)4.2×10−6 T;(b)3.63×10−5 T.Spectrumappearsnarrowerat650MHz. 15.11 2.9 × 103 s−1 . 15.14 (a) The H and F nuclei are both chemically and magnetically equivalent. (b) The P and H nuclei chemically and magnetically equivalent in both the cis- and trans-forms. 15.15 B1 = 9.40 × 10−4 T, 6.25 µs. 15.16 1.3 T. 15.17 g = 2.0022. 15.18 2.2 mT, g = 1.992. 15.19 Eight equal parts at ±1.445 ± 1.435 ± 1.055 mT from the centre, namely: 328.865, 330.975, 331.735, 331.755, 333.845, 333.865, 334.625 and 336.735 mT. 15.21 (a) 332.3 mT; (b)1209 mT. 15.22 I = 1. Chapter 16 16.1 T = 623 K. 16.2 (a) 15.9 pm, 5.04 pm; (b) 2.47 × 1026 , 7.82 × 1027 . 16.3 = 187.9. 16.4 q = 4.006. 16.5 E = 7.605 kJ mol−1 . 16.6 213 K. 16.7 (a) 0.997, 0.994; (b) 0.999 99, 0.999 98. 16.8 (a) (i) = 1.39 × 10−11 , = 1.93 × 10−22 ; (ii) = 0.368, = 0.135; (iii) = 0.779, = 0.607; (b) q = 1.503; (c) Um = 88.3 J mol−1 ; (d) Cv = 3.53 J K−1 mol−1 ; (e) Sm = 6.92 J K−1 mol−1 . 16.9 7.26 K. 16.10 (a) 147 J K−1 mol−1 ; (b) 169.6 J K−1 mol−1 . 16.11 10.7 J K−1 mol−1 . 16.12 (a) Chapter 17 17.1 (a) O3 : 3R [experimental = 3.7R] (b) C2H6 : 4R [experimental = 6.3R] (c) CO2 : 5 –2R [experimental = 4.5R] 17.2 With vibrations: 115, Without vibrations: 140, Experimental: 1.29. 17.3 (a) 143; (b) 251. 17.4 (a) 2; (b) 2; (c) 6; (d) 24; (e) 4. 17.5 qK = 5837, θR = 0.8479 K, T = 0.3335 K. 17.6 SR m = 84.57 J K−1 mol−1 . 17.7 (a) At 298 K, qR = 2.50 × 103 . At 500 K, qR = 5.43 × 103 ; (b) At 298 K, q = 2.50 × 103 . At 500 K, q = 5.43 × 103 . 17.8 (a) At 25°C, qR = 7.97 × 103 ; (b) At 100°C, qR = 1.12 × 104 . 17.9 (a) At 298 K, Sm = 5.88 J mol−1 K−1 . (b) At 500 K, Sm = 16.48 J mol−1 K−1 . 17.10 GR m − GR m(0) = −20.1 kJ mol−1 , GV m − GV m(0) = −0.110 kJ mol−1 . 17.11 −3.65 kJ mol−1 . 17.12 Sm = 14.9 J mol−1 K−1 . 17.14 K ≈ 0.25. n3 n1 n2 n1 n3 n1 n2 n1 n3 n1 n2 n1 qXe qHe 1032 SOLUTIONS TO B) EXERCISES Chapter 18 18.1 SF4. 18.2 µ = 1.4 D. 18.3 µ = 9.45 × 10−29 C m, θ = 194.0°. 18.4 µ = 3.23 × 10−30 C m, α = 2.55 × 10−39 C2 m2 J−1 . 18.5 εr = 8.97. 18.6 µ* = 3.71 × 10−36 C m. 18.7 α = 3.40 × 10−40 C2 m2 J−1 . 18.8 nr = 1.10. 18.9 εr = 16. 18.10 p = 5.92 kPa. 18.11 γ = 7.12 × 10−2 N m−1 . 18.12 pin − pout = 2.04 × 105 Pa. Chapter 19 19.1 •n = 68 kg mol−1 , •w = 69 kg mol−1 . 19.2 Rg = 1.06 × 104 . 19.3 (a) •n = 8.8 kg mol−1 ; (b) •w = 11 kg mol−1 . 19.4 τ = 9.4 × 10−8 s. 19.5 71. 19.6 •n = 120 kg mol−1 . 19.7 s = 1.47 × 10−4 m s−1 . 19.8 • = 56 kg mol−1 . 19.9 •w = 3.1 × 103 kg mol−1 . 19.10 a/g = 3.86 × 105 . 19.11 Rrms = 38.97 nm. 19.12 Rc = 1.26 × 10−6 m, Rrms = 1.97 × 10−8 m. Chapter 20 20.1 (1 –2,1 –2,0) and (0,1 –2,1 –2). 20.2 (3 1 3) and (6 4 3). 20.3 d121 = 214 pm, d221 = 174 pm, d244 = 87.2 pm. 20.4 λ = 86.7 pm. 20.5 hkl sin θ θ/° 2θ/° 111 0.327 19.1 38.2 200 0.378 22.2 44.4 220 0.535 32.3 64.6 20.6 D = 0.054 cm. 20.7 V = 1.2582 nm3 . 20.8 d = 5, d = 2.90 g cm−3 . 20.9 d322 = 182 pm. 20.10 (100), (110), (111), and (200). 20.11 hkl dhkl/pm θhkl/° 100 574.1 4.166 010 796.8 3.000 111 339.5 7.057 20.12 body-centred cubic. 20.13 Fhkl = 2f for h + k + l even; 0 for h + k + l odd. 20.14 2 –3. 20.15 = 0.732. 20.16 (a) 57 pm; (b) 111 pm. 20.17 = 0.370. 20.18 contraction. 20.20 λ = 252 pm. 20.21 ∆LH7 (MgBr2, s) = 2421 kJ mol−1 . 20.23 strain = 5.8 × 10−2 . 20.24 ∆V = 0.003 dm3 . 20.25 p-type. 20.26 2.71 × 104 H. 20.27 5. 20.28 −8.2 × 10−4 cm3 mol−1 . 20.29 χm = 1.58 × 10−8 m3 mol−1 , dimerization occurs. 20.30 2.52 = effective unpaired spins, theoretical number = 2. 20.31 χm = 1. 85 × 10−7 m3 mol−1 . 20.32 r = 0.935. Chapter 21 21.1 (a) 7.079; (b) 1. 21.2 (a) c = 4.75 × 102 m s−1 ; (b) λ = 4 × 104 m; (c) z = 0.01 s−1 . 21.3 p = 2.4 × 107 Pa. 21.4 λ = 4.1 × 10−7 m. 21.5 z = 9.9 × 108 s−1 . 21.6 (a) λ = 3.7 × 10−9 m; (b) λ = 5.5 × 10−8 m; (c) λ = 4.1 × 10−5 m. 21.7 F ≈ 9.6 × 10−2 . 21.8 N = 5.3 × 1021 . 21.9 ∆m = 4.98 × 10−4 kg. 21.10 Mfluorocarbon = 554 g mol−1 . 21.11 t = 1.5 × 104 s. 21.12 0.17 J m−2 s−1 . 21.13 1.61 × 10−19 m2 . 21.14 22 J s−1 . 21.15 3.00 × 10−19 m2 . 21.16 1.00 × 105 Pa. 21.17 (a) At 273 K: η = 0.95 × 10−5 kg m−1 s−1 ; (b) At 298 K: η = 0.99 × 10−5 kg m−1 s−1 ; (c) At 1000 K: η = 1.81 × 10−5 kg m−1 s−1 . 21.18 (a) κ = 0.0114 J m−1 s−1 K−1 , 0.017 J s−1 ; (b) κ = 9.0 × 10−3 J m−1 s−1 K−1 , 0.014 J s−1 . 21.19 52.0 × 10−7 kg m−1 s−1 , d = 923 pm. 21.20 κ = 9.0 × 10−3 J m−1 s−1 K−1 . 21.21 (a) D = 0.107 m2 s−1 , J = 0.87 mol m−2 s−1 ; (b) D = 1.07 × 10−5 m2 s−1 , J = 8.7 × 10−5 mol m−2 s−1 ; (c) D = 7.13 × 10−8 m2 s−1 , J = 5.8 × 10−7 mol m−2 s−1 . 21.22 4.09 × 10−3 S m2 mol−1 . 21.23 4.81 × 10−5 m V−1 s−1 . 21.24 0.604. 21.25 Λo m(MgI2) = 25.96 mS m2 mol−1 . 21.26 F− : u = 5.74 × 10−8 m2 V−1 s−1 ; Cl− : u = 7.913 × 10−8 m2 V−1 s−1 ; Br− : u = 8.09 × 10−8 m2 V−1 s−1 . 21.27 1.09 × 10−9 m2 s−1 . 21.28 4.1 × 103 s. 2Vatom Vcell r R SOLUTIONS TO B) EXERCISES 1033 21.29 207 pm. 21.30 200 × 10−11 s = 20 ps. 21.31 Iodine: (a) 78 s; (b) 7.8 × 103 s. Sucrose: (a) 3.2 × 102 s; (b) 3.2 × 104 s. Chapter 22 22.1 Rates of consumption of A = 1.0 mol dm−3 s−1 ; B = 3.0 mol dm−3 s−1 ; C = 1.0 mol dm−3 s−1 ; D = 2.0 mol dm−3 s−1 . 22.2 Rate of consumption of B = 1.00 mol dm−3 s−1 . Rate of reaction = 0.33 mol dm−3 s−1 . Rate of formation of C = 0.33 mol dm−3 s−1 . Rate of formation of D = 0.66 mol dm−3 s−1 . Rate of consumption of A = 0.33 mol dm−3 s−1 . 22.3 K: dm3 mol−2 s−1 . (a) v = = −k[A][B]2 ; (b) v = = k[A][B]2 . 22.4 v = k[A][B][C]−1 , K: s−1 . 22.5 2.00. 22.6 Reaction order = 0. 22.7 t1/2 = 1.80 × 106 s, (a) p = 31.5 kPa; (b) p = 29.0 kPa. 22.8 (a) k = 3.47 × 10−3 dm3 mol−1 s−1 ; (b) t1/2(A) = 2.4 h; t1/2(B) = 0.44 h. 22.9 (a) Second-order units: m3 molecule−1 s−1 , Third-order units: m6 molecule−2 s−1 ; (b) Second-order units; Pa−1 s−1 , Third-order units; Pa−2 s−1 . 22.10 (a) 6.5 × 10−3 mol dm−3 ; (b) 0.025 mol dm−3 . 22.11 1.5 × 106 s. 22.12 t1/3 = [A]0 1−n . 22.13 Kf = 1.7 × 10−7 s−1 , kr = 8.3 × 108 dm mol−1 s−1 . 22.14 Ea = 9.9 kJ mol−1 , A = 0.94 dm3 mol−1 s−1 . 22.15 (a) kT/kH ≈ 0.06; (b) k18/k16 ≈ 0.89. 22.16 ka = 9.9 × 10−6 s−1 Pa−1 = 9.9 s−1 MPa−1 . Chapter 23 23.2 = −k1[R2] − k2 1/2 [R2]3/2 . 23.3 (a) Does not occur. (b) p = 1.3 × 102 Pa to 3 × 104 Pa. 23.4 [HA]3/2 [B]. 23.5 = −k1[A2]. 23.6 υmax = 2.57 × 10−4 mol dm−3 s−1 . 23.7 1.5 × 10−5 moles of photons. 23.8 Φ = 1.11. Chapter 24 24.1 z = 6.64 × 109 s−1 , ZAA = 8.07 × 1034 m−3 s−1 , 1.6 per cent. 24.2 (a) (i) 2.4 × 10−3 , (ii) 0.10; (b) (i) 7.7 × 10−27 , (ii) 1.6 × 10−10 . 24.3 (a) (i) 1.2, (ii) 1.03; (b) (i) 7.4, (ii) 1.3. 24.4 k = 1.7 × 10−12 dm−3 mol−1 s−1 . 24.5 kd = 3.2 × 107 m3 mol−1 s−1 or 3.2 × 1010 dm3 mol−1 s−1 . 24.6 (a) kd = 1.97 × 106 m3 mol−1 s−1 ; (b) kd = 2.4 × 105 m3 mol−1 s−1 . 24.7 kd = 1.10 × 107 m3 mol−1 s−1 or 1.10 × 1010 dm3 mol−1 s−1 , t1/2 = 5.05 × 10−8 s. d[A2] dt k1k2Ka 1/2 k′1 D E F k1 k4 A B C d[R2] dt 3n−1 − 1 k(n −1) d[C] dt d[A] dt 24.8 P = 1.41 × 10−3 . 24.9 v = 1.54 × 108 mol dm−3 s−1 . 24.10 ∆‡ H = 48.52 kJ mol−1 , ∆‡ S = −32.2 J K−1 mol−1 . 24.11 ∆‡ G = 46.8 kJ mol−1 . 24.12 ∆‡ S = −93 J K−1 mol−1 . 24.13 ∆‡ S = −80.0 J K−1 mol−1 . 24.14 (a) ∆‡ S = −24.1 J K−1 mol−1 ; (b) ∆‡ H = 27.5 kJ mol−1 ; (c) ∆‡ G = 34.7 kJ mol−1 . 24.15 k°2 = 1.08 dm6 mol−2 min−1 . 24.16 λ = 1.531 eV, ͗HDA͘ = 9.39 × 10−24 J. 24.17 ket = 1.4 × 103 s−1 . Chapter 25 25.1 (a) (i) 2.88 × 1019 cm−2 s−1 , (ii) 5.75 × 1013 cm−2 s−1 ; (b) (i) 3.81 × 1019 cm−2 s−1 , (ii) 7.60 × 1013 cm−2 s−1 . 25.2 p = 7.3 × 102 Pa. 25.3 6.6 × 104 s−1 . 25.4 A = 18.8 m2 . 25.5 Vmon = 9.7 cm3 . 25.6 t1/2 = 200 s. 25.7 Ed = 3.7 × 103 J mol−1 . 25.8 (a) 0.32 kPa; (b) 3.9 kPa. 25.9 θ1 = 0.75, θ2 = 0.25. 25.10 (a) At 400 K: 4.9 × 10−11 s, At 800 K: 2.4 × 10−12 s; (b) At 400 K: 1.6 × 1013 s, At 800 K: 1.4 s. 25.11 p2 = 6.50 kPa. 25.12 (a) θ = ; (b) θ = ; (c) θ = . A plot of θ versus p at low pressures (where the denominator is approximately 1) would show progressively weaker dependence on p for dissociation into two or three fragments. 25.13 ∆adH7 = −6.40 kJ mol−1 . 25.14 Ed = 2.85 × 105 J mol−1 . (a) t = 1.48 × 1036 s; (b) t = 1.38 × 10−4 s. 25.15 ε = 2.8 × 108 Vm−1 . 25.16 167 mV. 25.17 j0 = 1.6 mA cm−2 . 25.18 j2 = 8.5 mA cm−2 . 25.19 (a) j = 0.34 A cm−2 ; (b) j = 0.34 A cm−2 . The validity of the Tafel equation improves as the overpotential increases. 25.20 jlim = 1.3 A m−2 . 25.21 [Fe2+ ] = 4 × 10−6 mol dm−3 . 25.22 j = (2.5 mA cm−2 ) × [(e(0.42)E′/f × (3.41 × 10−6 ) − e(−0.58)E′/f × (3.55 × 107 )]. 25.23 At r = 0.1: j/j0 = 1.5 A cm−2 , At r = 1: j/j0 = 4.8 A cm−2 , At r = 10: j/j0 = 15 A cm−2 . 25.24 0.61 V. 25.25 For the Cu, H2|H+ electrode: N = 6.2 × 1012 s−1 cm−2 , f = 4.2 × 10−3 s−1 . For the Pt|Ce4+ , Ce3+ electrode: N = 2.5 × 1014 s−1 cm−2 , f = 0.17 s−1 . 25.26 (a) 5.1 GΩ; (b) 10 GΩ. 25.29 Deposition would not occur. 25.30 Iron can be deposited. 25.31 E7 = 1.80 V, P = 0.180 W. 25.32 3.0 mm y−1 . (Kp)1/3 1 + (Kp)1/3 (Kp)1/2 1 + (Kp)1/2 Kp 1 + Kp Chapter 1 1.1 −233°N. 1.3 −272.95°C. 1.5 (a) ∆p = 0.0245 kPa; (b) p = 9.14 kPa; (c) ∆p = 0.0245 kPa. 1.7 (a) Vm = 12.5 dm3 mol−1 ; (b) Vm = 12.3 dm3 mol−1 . 1.9 (a) 0.944 dm3 mol−1 ; (b) 2.69 dm3 mol−1 , 2.67 dm3 mol−1 ; (c) 5.11 dm3 mol−1 1.11 (a) 0.1353 dm3 mol−1 ; (b) 0.6957; (c) 0.72. 1.13 b = 59.4 cm3 mol−1 , a = 5.649 dm6 atm mol−2 , p = 21 atm. 1.15 B = b − , C = b2 , b = 34.6 cm3 mol−1 , a = 1.26 dm6 atm mol−2 . 1.17 Vc = , Tc = , pc = , Zc = 1.19 B′ = 0.082 atm−1 , B = 2.0 dm3 mol−1 . 1.21 No. 1.23 0.011. 1.25 4.1 × 108 dm3 1.27 (a) 0.00; (b) −0.72 1.31 h = 51.5 km. p = 3.0 × 10−3 bar. Chapter 2 2.1 T1 = 273 K = T3, T2 = 546 K Step 1 → 2: w = −2.27 × 103 J ∆U = +3.40 × 103 J q = +5.67 × 103 J ∆H = +5.67 × 103 J Step 2 → 3: w = 0 qv = ∆U = −3.40 × 103 J ∆H = −5.67 × 103 J Step 3 → 1: ∆U = ∆H = 0 −q = w = +1.57 × 103 J Cycle: ∆U = ∆H = 0 q = −w = +0.70 × 103 J 2.3 w = 0, ∆U = +2.35 kJ, ∆H = +3.03 kJ, 2.5 (a) w = 0, ∆U = +6.19 kJ, q = +6.19 kJ, ∆H = +8.67 kJ; (b) q = 0, ∆U = −6.19 kJ, ∆H = −8.67 kJ, w = −6.19 kJ; (c) ∆U = ∆H = 0, −q = w = +4.29 kJ. (a) w0 = −1.7 kJ; (b) w = −1.8 kJ; (c) w = −1.5 kJ. 2.7 −87.33 kJ mol−1 . 2.9 ∆rH7 = +17.7 kJ mol−1 , ∆fH7 (metallocene, 583 K) = +116.0 kJ mol−1 . 2.11 (c) n = 0.903, k = −73.7 kJ mol−1 . 2.13 ∆cH7 = 25 968 kJ mol−1 , ∆fH7 (C60) = 2357 kJ mol−1 . 2.15 (a) 240 kJ mol−1 ; (b) 228 kJ mol−1 . 2.17 41.40 J K−1 mol−1 . 2.19 3.60 kJ. 2.21 (a) dz = (2x − 2y + 2)dx + (4y − 2x − 4)dy (c) dz = y + dx + (x − 1)dy D E F 1 x A B C 1 3 B3 27C2 B2 3RC 3C B a RT Solutions to odd problems 2.25 (a) p = 1 + p p = 1 + (b) p = 1 + = 1 + p p 2.27 (a) −1.5 kJ, (b) −1.6 kJ. 2.29 increase. 2.37 (a) µ = (b) Cv = Cp − R 1 + 2 2.39 7.4%. 2.41 (a) −25 kJ; (b) 9.7 m; (c) 39 kJ; (d) 15 m. 2.45 ∆T = 2°C, ∆h = 1.6 m, ∆T = 1°C, ∆h = 0.8 m, ∆T = 3.5°C, ∆h = 2.8 m. 2.47 (a) 23.5 K MPa−1 ; (b) 14.0 K MPa−1 . Chapter 3 3.1 (a) ∆trsS(l→s, −5°C) = −21.3 J K−1 mol−1 , ∆Ssur = +21.7 J K−1 mol−1 , ∆Stotal = +0.4 J K−1 mol−1 . (b) ∆trsS (l→g, T) = +109.7 J K−1 mol−1 , ∆Ssur = −111.2 J K−1 mol−1 , ∆Stotal = −1.5 J K−1 mol−1 . 3.3 (a) q(Cu) = 43.9 kJ, q(H2O) = −43.9 kJ, ∆S(H2O) = −118.1 J K−1 , ∆S(Cu) = 145.9 J K−1 , ∆S(total) = 28 J K−1 . (b) θ = 49.9°C = 323.1 K, q(Cu) = 38.4 kJ = −q(H2O), ∆S(H2O) = −119.8 J K−1 , ∆S(Cu) = 129.2 J K−1 , ∆S(total) = 9 J K−1 . 3.5 Step 1 Step 2 Step 3 Step 4 Cycle q +11.5 kJ 0 –5.74 kJ 0 −5.8 kJ w −11.5 kJ −3.74 kJ +5.74 kJ +3.74 kJ −5.8 kJ ∆U 0 −3.74 kJ 0 +3.74 kJ 0 ∆H 0 −6.23 kJ 0 +6.23 kJ 0 ∆S +19.1 J K−1 0 −19.1 J K−1 0 0 ∆Stot 0 0 0 0 0 ∆G −11.5 kJ Indeterminate +11.5 kJ Indeterminate 0 3.7 (a) 200.7 J K−1 mol−1 ; (b) 232.0 J K−1 mol−1 . 3.9 ∆S = nCp,m ln + nCp,m ln , ∆S = +22.6 J K−1 . 3.11 (a) 63.88 J K−1 mol−1 ; (b) 66.08 J K−1 mol−1 . 3.13 H7 m(200 K) − H7 m(0) = 32.1 kJ mol−1 . 3.15 46.60 J K−1 mol−1 . 3.17 (a) −7 kJ mol−1 ; (b) +107 kJ mol−1 . 3.29 πT ≈ × (a) 3.0 × 10−3 atm; (b) 0.30 atm. 3.31 πT = 3.33 T dS = CpdT − αTV dp, qrev = −αTV ∆p, qrev = −0.50 kJ nap RTV ∆B ∆T p2 R Tf Tc Tf Th D E F 2apT R A B C aT2 Cp D E F ∂V ∂U A B C p (∂U/∂V)p D E F ∂H ∂U A B C p (∂U/∂V)p D E F ∂V ∂U A B C D E F ∂H ∂U A B C SOLUTIONS TO ODD PROBLEMS 1035 3.35 lnφ = + + . . . f = 0.9991 atm 3.37 −21 kJ mol−1 . 3.39 13 per cent increase. 3.43 ε = 1 − 1/c ε = 0.47 ∆S1 = ∆S3 = ∆Ssur,1 = ∆Ssur,2 = 0 [adiabatic reversible steps] ∆S2 = ∆Ssur,4 = +33 J K−1 = −∆Ssur,2 = −∆S4 3.45 (a) 1.00 kJ; (b) 8.4 kJ. Chapter 4 4.1 196.0 K, 11.1 Torr. 4.3 (a) 5.56 kPa K−1 ; (b) 2.5 per cent. 4.5 (a) −1.63 cm3 mol−1 ; (b) +30.1 dm3 mol−1 , +0.6 kJ mol−1 . 4.7 22°C. 4.9 (a) Tb = 227.5°C; (b) ∆vapH = +53 kJ mol−1 ; 4.11 (b) 171.18 K; (c) T = 383.6 K; (d) 33.0 kJ mol−1 . 4.15 9.8 Torr. 4.17 − × Cp,m. 4.21 (a) ∆Ur(Tr,Vr) = − Ύ ∞ Trconstant dVr; (c) 0.85 to 0.90. 4.23 ∆vapH = 1.60 × 104 bar. Chapter 5 5.1 kA = 15.58 kPa,kB = 47.03 kPa. 5.3 Vsalt = −1.4 cm3 mol−1 , VH20 = 18.04 cm3 mol−1 . 5.5 VE = 57.9 cm3 , VW = 45.8 cm3 , ∆V = +0.96 cm3 . 5.7 4 ions. 5.11 (a) propionic acid: V1 = Vm,1 + a0x2 2 + a1(3x1 − x2)x2 2, oxane: V2 = Vm,2 + a0x2 1 + a1(x1 − 3x2)x2 1, (b) V1 = 75.63 cm3 mol−1 , V2 = 99.06 cm3 mol−1 . 5.13 KH = 371 bar, γCO2 = 1.01 (at 10p/bar), 0.99(at 20p/bar), 1.00(at 30p/bar), 0.99 (at 40p/bar), 0.98(at 60p/bar), 0.94 (at 80p/bar). 5.15 ∆mixG = −4.6 kJ. 5.17 µA = µA* + RT lnxA + gRTx2 B 5.19 80.36 cm3 mol−1 . 5.25 pN2 at 4.0 atm = 56 µg, pN2 at 1.0 atm = 14 µg, increase = 1.7 × 102 µg N2. 5.29 (a) g cm K−1 mol−1 , (b) M = 1.1 × 105 g mol−1 , (d) B′ = 21.4 cm3 g−1 , C′ = 211 cm6 g−2 , (e) B′ = 28.0 cm3 g−1 , C′ = 196 cm6 g−2 . Chapter 6 6.1 (b) 391.0 K; (c) = 0.532. 6.3 Temperature (γO2 ): 0.877 (78 K), 1.079 (80 K), 1.039 (82 K), 0.995 (84 K), 0.993 (86 K), 0.990 (88 K), 0.987 (90.2 K). 6.7 MgCu2: 16 per cent mg by mass, Mg2Cu: 43 per cent mg by mass. 6.9 (a) Eutectic: 40.2 at per cent Si at 1268°C; 69.4 at per cent Si at 1030°C. Congruent melting compounds: Ca2Si = 1314°C; CaSi = 1324°C. Incongruent melting compounds: CaSi2 = 1040°C; nliq nvap 2pr(Tr,Vr) TrVr 1 T D E F VB VA A B C (C − B2 )p2 2R2 T2 Bp RT (b) At 1000°C, the phases at equilibrium will be Ca(s) and liquid (13 at per cent Si). Relative amounts, nCa/nliq = 2.86; (c) (i) nSi/nliq = 0.53 at slightly above 1030°C, (ii) nSi/nCaSi2 = 0.665 slightly below 1030°C. 6.13 (i) Below a denaturant concentration of 0.1 only the native and unfolded forms are stable. 6.19 (a) 2150°C (b) y(MgO) = 0.18, x(MgO) = 0.35, (c) c = 2640°C. 6.21 (b) nliq/nvap = 10.85. Chapter 7 7.1 (a) ∆rG7 = +4.48 kJ mol−1 ; (b) pIBr = 0.101 atm. 7.3 ∆fH7 = 8.48 R. 7.5 ∆rG7 (T)/(kJ mol−1 ) = 78 − 0.161 × (T/K). 7.7 First experiment, K = 0.740, second experiment, K = 5.71, enthalpy of dimerization = −103 kJ mol−1 . 7.9 ∆H7 = +158 kJ mol−1 . 7.11 (a) At 298 K: 1.2 × 108 ; (b) At 700 K: 2.7 × 103 . 7.13 (a) CuSO4: 4.0 × 10−3 ; ZnSO4: 1.2 × 10−2 ; (b) γ± (CuSO4) = 0.74, γ± (ZnSO4) = 0.60; (c) Q = 5.9; (d) E7 = +1.102 V; (e) E = +1.079 V. 7.15 pH = 2.0. 7.17 E7 = +0.268 43 V, γ± = 0.9659 (1.6077 mmol kg−1 ), 0.9509 (3.0769 mmol kg−1 ), 0.9367 (5.0403 mmol kg−1 ), 0.9232 (7.6938 mmol kg−1 ), 0.9094 (10.9474 mmol kg−1 ), 7.19 γ = 0.533. 7.21 (a) T,n = − ; (b) 2.80 × 10−3 mV atm−1 ; (c) the linear fit and constancy of are very good; (d) 3.2 × 10−7 atm−1 . 7.23 −1.15 V. 7.25 ξ = 1 − 1/2 7.31 Yes. 7.33 (b) +0.206 V. 7.35 (iv) HNO3·3H2O is most stable. Chapter 8 8.1 (a) ∆E = 1.6 × 1033 J m−3 ; (b) ∆E = 2.5 × 10−4 J m−3 . 8.3 (a) θE = 2231 K, = 0.031; (b) θE = 343 K, = 0.897. 8.5 (a) 9.0 × 10−6 ; (b) 1.2 × 10−6 . 8.13 (a) N = 1/2 ; (b) N = ; (c) N = ; (d) N = . 8.15 (a) Yes, eigenvalue = ik; (b) No; (c) Yes, eigenvalue = 0; (d) No; (e) No. 8.17 (a) Yes, eigenvalue = −k2 ; (b) Yes, eigenvalue = −k2 ; (c) Yes, eigenvalue = 0; (d) Yes, eigenvalue = 0; (e) No. Hence, (a,b,c,d) are eigenfunctions of ; (b,d) are eigenfunctions of , but not of . d dx d2 dx2 d2 dx2 1 (32πa5 )1/2 1 (πa3 )1/2 1 c(2L)1/2 D E F 2 L A B C CV 3R CV 3R D E F 1 1 + ap/p7 A B C D E F ∂E ∂p A B C ∆rV νF D E F ∂E ∂p A B C 1036 SOLUTIONS TO ODD PROBLEMS 8.19 . 8.21 (a) r = 6a0, r2 = 42a0 2 ; (b) r = 5a0, r2 = 30a0 2 . 8.27 (a) λrelativistic = 5.35 pm. 8.29 (a) Methane is unstable above 825 K; (b) λmax (1000 K) = 2880 nm; (c) Excitance ratio = 7.7 × 10−4 ; Energy density ratio = 8.8 × 10−3 ; (d) 2.31 × 10−7 , it hardly shines. Chapter 9 9.1 E2 − E1 = 1.24 × 10−39 J, n = 2.2 × 109 J, En − En−1 = 1.8 × 10−30 J. 9.3 E1 = 1.30 × 10−22 J, minimum angular momentum = ±η. 9.5 (a) E1 (1) = + sin ; (b) E1 (1) = + sin = 0.1984ε. 9.11 (a) P = ; (b) ͗x͘ = . 9.13 ͗T͘ = v + $ω. 9.15 (a) δx = L − 1/2 , δp = ; (b) δx = v + 1/2 , δp = v + $ωm 1/2 . 9.19 ͗T͘ = −1 –2͗V͘. 9.23 (a) E = 0, angular momentum = 0; (b) E = , angular momentum = 61/2 $; (c) E = , angular momentum = . 9.25 θ = arccos , 54°44′. 9.31 (a) ∆E = 3.3 × 10−19 J; (b) v = 4.95 × 10−14 J s−1 ; (c) lower, increases. 9.33 ω = 2.68 × 10−14 J s−1 . 9.35 (a) lz = 5.275 × 10−34 J s, E±5 = 1.39 × 10−24 J; (b) v = 9.2 × 108 Hz. 9.37 F = 5.8 × 10−11 N. Chapter 10 10.1 n2 → 6, transitions occur at 12 372 nm, 7503 nm, 5908 nm, 5129 nm, . . . , 3908 nm (at n2 = 15), converging to 3282 nm as n2 → ∞. 10.3 RLi2+ = 987 663 cm−1 , the Balmer transitions lie at # = 137 175 cm−1 , 85 187 cm−1 , 122.5 eV. 10.5 2 P1/2 and 2 P3/2, of which the former has the lower energy, 2 P3/2 and 2 P5/2 of which the former has the lower energy, the ground state will be 2 P3/2. 10.7 3.3429 × 10−24 kg, = 1.000 272. 10.9 (a) ∆# = 0.9 cm−1 , (b) Normal Zeeman splitting is small compared to the difference in energy of the states involved in the transition. 10.11 ±106 pm. 10.13 (b) For 3s, ρnode = 3 + √3 and ρnode = 3 − √3, no nodal plane; for 3px, ρnode = 0 and ρnode = 4, yz nodal plane (φ = 90°); for 3dxy, ρnode = 0, xz nodal plane (φ = 0) and yz nodal plane (φ = 90°); (c) (r)3s = . 10.17 ͗r−1 ͘1s = ; (b) ͗r−1 ͘2s = ; (c) ͗r−1 ͘2p = . Z 4a0 Z 4a0 Z a0 27a0 2 ID IH ml {l(l + 1)}1/2 2 3$ 6$2 I 3$2 I J K L D E F 1 2 A B C G H I J K L $ ωm D E F 1 2 A B C G H I nh 2L D E F 1 2π2 n2 1 12 A B C D E F 1 2 A B C 1 2 N2 4κ2 N2 2κ D E F π 10 A B C ε π ε 10 D E F πa L A B C ε π εa L $2 k2 2m 10.25 The wavenumbers for n = 3 → n = 2: 4 He = 60 957.4 cm−1 , 3 He = 60 954.7 cm−1 . The wavenumbers for n = 2 → n = 1: 4 He = 329 170 cm−1 , 3 He = 329 155 cm−1 . 10.27 (a) receeding; s = 3.381 × 105 ms−1 . Chapter 11 11.3 R = 2.1a0. 11.7 (a) P = 8.6 × 10−7 /P = 2.0 × 10−6 ; (b) P = 8.6 × 10−7 /P = 2.0 × 10−6 ; (c) P = 3.7 × 10−7 /P = 0; (d) P = 4.9 × 10−7 / P = 5.5 × 10−7 . 11.13 Delocalization energy = 2{Ewith resonance − Ewithout resonance} = {(αO − αN)2 + 12β2 }1/2 − {(αO − αN)2 + 4β2 }1/2 11.15 (a) C2H4: −3.813, C4H6: −4.623, C6H8: −5.538, C8H10: −5.873; (b) 8.913 eV. 11.29 (a) linear relationship; (b) E7 = −0.122 V; (c) E7 = −0.174 V, ubiquinone a better oxidizing agent than plastiquinone. Chapter 12 12.1 (a) D3d; (b) chair: D3d, boat: C2V; (c) D2h; (d) D3; (d) D4d; (i) Polar: Boat C6H12; (ii) Chiral: [Co(en)3]3+ . 12.3 C2σh = i. 12.7 1 σx σy σz 1 1 σx σy σz σx σx 1 iσx −iσy σy σy − 1 iσx iσz σz σz iσy − 1 iσz The matrices do not form a group since the products iσz, iσy, iσx and their negatives are not among the four given matrices. 12.9 All five d orbitals may contribute to bonding. (b) All except A2(dxy) may participate in bonding. 12.11 (a) D2h ;(b) (i) Staggered: C2h; (ii) Eclipsed: C2V. 12.13 (a) C2V, f → 2A1 + A2 + 2B1 + 2B2; (b) C3V, f → + A2 + 3E; (c) Td, f → A1 + T1 + T2; (d) Oh, f → A2U + T1U + T2U. Lanthanide ion (a) tetrahedral complex: f → A1 + T1 + T2 in Td symmetry, and there is one nondegenerate orbital and two sets of triply degenerate orbitals. (b) octahedral complex: f → A2U + T1U + T2U, and the pattern of splitting is the same. 12.15 irreducible representations: 4A1 + 2B1 + 3B2 + A2 Chapter 13 13.1 T/K E/J m−3 Eclass/J m−3 (a) 1500 2.136 × 10−6 2.206 (b) 2500 9.884 × 10−4 3.676 (c) 5800 3.151 × 10−1 8.528 SOLUTIONS TO ODD PROBLEMS 1037 13.3 τ = = 1/2 , δν ≈ 700 MHz, below 1 Torr. 13.5 R0 = 112.83 pm, R1 = 123.52 pm. 13.7 I = 2.728 × 10−47 kg m2 , R = 129.5 pm, hence we expect lines at 10.56, 21.11, 31.67, . . . cm−1 . 13.9 218 pm. 13.11 B = 14.35 m−1 , Jmax = 26 at 298 K, Jmax = 15 at 100 K. 13.13 linear. 13.15 (a) 5.15 eV; (b) 5.20 eV. 13.17 (a) # = 152 m−1 , k = 2.72 × 10−4 kg s−2 , I = 2.93 × 10−46 kg m2 , B = 95.5 m−1 . (b) xe = 0.96. 13.19 (a) C3v; (b) 9; (c) 2A1 + A2 + 3E. (d) All but the A2 mode are infrared active. (e) All but the A2 mode may be Raman active. 13.23 (a) spherical rotor; (b) symmetric rotor; (c) linear rotor; (d) asymmetric rotor; (e) symmetric rotor; (f) asymmetric rotor. 13.25 HgCl2: 230, HgBr2: 240, HgI2: 250 pm. 13.27 (a) infrared active; (b) 796 cm−1 ; (c) O2: 2, O2 − : 1.5, O2 2− : 1; (d) Fe2 3+ O2 2− ; (e) Structures 6 and 7 are consistent with this observation, but structures 4 and 5 are not. 13.29 s = 0.0768 c, T = 8.34 × 105 K. 13.31 B = 2.031 cm−1 ; T = 2.35 K. Chapter 14 14.1 49 364 cm−1 . 14.3 14 874 cm−1 . 14.5 A = 1.1 × 106 dm3 mol−1 cm−2 , Excitations from A1 to A1, B1, and B2 terms are allowed. 14.7 5.06 eV. 14.9 Hydrocarbon EHOMO/eV* Benzene −9.7506 Biphenyl −8.9169 Naphthalene −8.8352 Phenanthrene −8.7397 Pyrene −8.2489 Anthracene −8.2477 14.11 (a) = 1.7 × 10−9 mol dm−3 , (b) N = 6.0 × 102 . 14.15 The transition moves toward the red as the chain lengthens and the apparent color of the dye shifts towards blue. 14.21 (a) 3 + 1, 3 + 3; (b) 4 + 4, 2 + 2. 14.23 4.4 × 103 . 14.25 A = 1.24 × 105 dm3 mol−1 dm−2 . 14.27 (a) A = 2.24 × 105 dm3 mol−1 cm−2 ; (b) A = 0.185; (c) ε = 135 dm3 mol−1 cm−1 . 14.29 V1 − V0 = 3.1938 eV, #1 − #0 = 79.538 cm−1 , #0 = 2034.3 cm−1 , Teff = 1321 K. Chapter 15 15.1 B0 = 10.3 T, ≈ 2.42 × 10−5 , β state lies lower. 15.3 300 × 10−6 Hz ± 10 Hz, 0.29 s. δN N n V D E F πm kT A B C kT 4σp 1 z 15.5 Both fit the data equally well. 15.9 Width of the CH3 spectrum is 3aH = 6.9 mT. The width of the CD3 spectrum is 6aD. The overall width is 6aD = 2.1 mT. 15.11 P(N2s) = 0.10, P(N2pz) = 0.38, total probability: P(N) = 0.48, P(O) = 0.52, hybridization ratio = 3.8, Φ = 131°. 15.13 σd = = 1.78 × 10−5 Z. 15.15 R = 158 pm. 15.17 I(ω) ≈ . 15.21 (cos2 θmax + cosθmax), ͗Bnucl͘ = 0.58 mT. Chapter 16 16.1 W = 2 × 1040 , S = 1.282 × 10−21 J K−1 , S1 = 0.637 × 10−21 J K−1 , S2 = 0.645 × 10−21 J K−1 . 16.3 ≈ 2.4 × 1025 . 16.5 T = 3.5 × 10−15 K, q = 7.41. 16.7 (a) (i) q = 5.00; (ii) q = 6.26; (b) p0 = 1.00 at 298 K, p0 = 0.80 at 5000 K; p2 = 6.5 × 10−11 at 298 K, p2 = 0.12 at 5000 K. (c) (i) Sm = 13.38 J K−1 mol−1 , (ii) Sm = 18.07 J K−1 mol−1 . 16.9 (a) p0 = 0.64, p1 = 0.36; (b) 0.52 kJ mol−1 . At 300 K, Sm = 11.2 J K−1 mol−1 , At 500 K, Sm = 11.4 J K−1 mol−1 . 16.11 (a) At 100 K: q = 1.049, p0 = 0.953, p1 = 0.044, p2 = 0.002; Um − Um(0) = 123 J mol−1 , Sm = 1.63 J K−1 mol−1 . (b) At 298 K: q = 1.55, p0 = 0.645, p1 = 0.230, p2 = 0.083, Um − Um(0) = 1348 J mol−1 , Sm = 8.17 J K−1 mol−1 . 16.13 Most probable configurations are {2, 2, 0, 1, 0, 0} and {2, 1, 2, 0, 0, 0} jointly. 16.15 (a) T = 160 K. Chapter 17 17.1 (a) 0.351; (b) 0.079; (c) 0.029. 17.3 CV,m = 4.2 J K−1 mol−1 , Sm = 15 J K−1 mol−1 . 17.5 q = 19.90. 17.7 S7 m = 199.4 J mol−1 K−1 . 17.11 At 298 K: K = 3.89. At 800 K: K = 2.41. 17.13 (a) θR = 87.55 K, θV = 6330 K. 17.16 (b) Jmax = 1/2 − ; (c) T ≈ 374 K. 17.17 (a) qR = 660.6; (b) qR = 4.26 × 104 . 17.23 S = 9.57 × 10−15 J K−1 . 17.25 G7 m − G7 m(0) = 513.5 kJ mol−1 . 17.27 At 10 K, G7 m − G7 m(0) = 660.8 J mol−1 . At 1000 K, G7 m − G7 m(0) = 241.5 kJ mol−1 . Chapter 18 18.1 (a) ε = 1.1 × 108 V m−1 ; (b) ε = 4 × 109 V m−1 ; (c) ε = 4 kV m−1 . 18.3 α′ = 1.2 × 10−23 cm3 , µ = 0.86 D. 18.5 α′ = 2.24 × 10−24 cm3 , µ = 1.58 D, P′m = 5.66 cm3 mol−1 , µ = 1.58 D. 18.7 (a) ε = 1.51 × 10−23 J, Re = 265 pm. 1 2 D E F kT 2hcB A B C ∆W W −gIµNµ0mI 4πR3 Aτ 1 + (ω0 − ω)2 τ2 1 2 e2 µ0Z 12πmea0 1038 SOLUTIONS TO ODD PROBLEMS 18.9 Pm = 8.14 cm3 mol−1 , εr = 1.76, nr = 1.33. 18.19 (a) V = −39 J mol−1 , (b) The force approaches zero as the distance becomes very large. 18.21 (a) µ = 1.03 × 10−29 C m; (b) Vmax = 3.55 × 10−23 J. Chapter 19 19.1 S = 4.97 × 10−13 s or 5.0 Sv. 19.3 [η] = 0.0716 dm3 g−1 . 19.5 M = 158 kg mol−1 . 19.7 (a) K = 0.0117 cm3 g−1 and a = 0.717. 19.9 •n = 155 kg mol−1 , B = 13.7 m3 mol−1 . 19.13 •n ≈ • + 1/2 . 19.15 (a) Rrms = lN1/2 , Rrms = 9.74 nm; (b) Rmean = 1/2 l, Rmean = 8.97 nm; (c) R* = l N 1/2 , R* = 7.95 nm; 19.17 (a) Rg = 1/2 a (b) . When M = 100 kg mol−1 , Rg/nm = 2.40. For a rod of radius 0.50 nm, Rg = 46 nm. 19.23 vp = 8vmol For BSV, B = 28 m3 mol−1 . For Hb, B = 0.33 m3 mol−1 . For BSV, = 2.6 × 10−2 corresponding to 2.6 per cent. For Hb, = 5.0 × 10−2 corresponding to 5 per cent. 19.25 (a) θ / ° 20 45 90 Irod / Icc 0.976 0.876 0.514 (b) 90°. 19.27 •n = 69 kg mol−1 , a = 3.4 nm. 19.29 pH = 3.85. Chapter 20 20.1 λ = 118 pm. 20.3 Yes, the data support. 20.5 face-centred cubic, a = 408.55 pm, ρ = 10.507 g cm−3 . 20.7 a(KCl) = 628 pm, are broadly conistent. 20.9 ρ = 7.654 g cm−3 . 20.11 ρ = 1.01 g cm−3 . 20.15 ρ = 1.385 g cm−3 , ρos = 1.578 g cm−3 . 20.17 0.736 eV. 20.19 For S = 2, χm = 0.127 × 10−6 m3 mol−1 , For S = 3, χm = 0.254 × 10−6 m3 mol−1 , For S = 4, χm = 0.423 × 10−6 m3 mol−1 . 20.21 x = 0.41. 20.23 For a monoclinic cell, V = abc sin β. For an orthorhombic cell, V = abc. 20.25 Fhkl ∝ 1 + e5iπ + e6iπ + e7iπ = 1 − 1 + 1 −1 = 0. 20.31 ξ = , χm = . −NAµ0e2 a2 0 2me −e2 a2 0 2me Π − Π° Π° Π − Π° Π° R l g = 2 3 D E F 3 5 A B C D E F 2 3 A B C D E F 8N 3π A B C D E F 2γ π A B C Chapter 21 21.3 (a) ͗h͘ = 1.89 m; (b) = 1.89 m. 21.5 p = 7.3 × 10−3 Pa, or 7.3 mPa. 21.7 (a) Cadmium: 2 × 1014 s−1 ; (b) Mercury: 1 × 1017 s−1 . 21.9 Λ°m = 12.6 mS m2 mol−1 ; K = 7.30 mS m2 mol−1 M−1/2 . (a) Λm = 11.96 mS m2 mol−1 ; (b) κ = 119.6 mS m−1 ; (c) R = 172.5 Ω. 21.11 s(Li+ ) = 4.0 × 10−3 cm s−1 , s(Na+ ) = 5.2 × 10−3 cm s−1 ; s(K+ ) = 7.6 × 10−3 cm s−1 . t(Li+ ) = 250 s, t(Na+ ) = 190 s, t(K+ ) = 130 s. (a) d(Li+ ) = 1.3 × 10−6 cm; d(Na+ ) = 1.7 × 10−6 cm; d(K+ ) = 2.4 × 10−6 cm. (b) 43, 55 and 81 solvent molecule diameters respectively. 21.13 t+ = 0.48 and t− = 0.52. u+ = 7.5 × 10−4 cm2 s−1 V−1 . λ+ = 72 S cm2 mol− 1 . 21.15 (a) 2.1 × 10−20 N molecule−1 ; (b) 2.8 × 10−20 N molecule−1 ; (c) 4.1 × 10−20 N molecule−1 . 21.17 9.3 kJ mol−1 . 21.19 1.2 × 10−3 kg m−1 s−1 . 21.21 (a) 3.68 × 10−10 m; (b) 3.07 × 10−10 m. 21.25 ͗vx͘ = 0.47 ͗vx͘initial. 21.27 = [24.4] = n2 e−(n2 −1)mc*2 /2kT = n2 e(1−n2 ) , = 3.02 × 10−3 , = 4.9 × 10−6 . 21.31 (a) p = 0; (b) p = 0.016; (c) p = 0.054. 21.37 The total energy density (translational plus rotational) = ρT = 0.25 J cm−3 . 21.39 t = 108 s. Chapter 22 22.1 Second-order, k = 0.0594 dm3 mol−1 min−1 , m = 2.94 g. 22.3 First-order, k = 1.23 × 10−4 s−1 . 22.5 9.70 × 104 J mol−1 . 22.7 k = 3.65 × 10−3 min−1 , t1/2 = 190 min. 22.9 k = 2.37 × 107 dm3 mol−1 s−1 , t1/2 = 4.98 × 10−3 s. 22.11 Propene: first order, HCl: third-order. 22.13 rate = kK1K2[HCl]3 [CH3CH=CH2]; look for evidence of proposed intermediates, e.g. using infrared spectroscopy to search for (HCl)2. 22.15 Ea,eff = −18 kJ mol−1 , Ea = +10 kJ mol−1 . 22.17 There are marked deviations at low pressures, indicating that the Lindemann theory is deficient in that region. 22.19 The product concentration ratio increases. 22.23 (a) kt = ; (b) kt = + ln 22.27 vmax = k 2 ; 22.29 2720 y. 22.31 (a) First-order, (b) k = 0.00765 min−1 = 0.459 h−1 , t1/2 = 1.5 h = 91 min. 22.35 v = k[A][B], k = . 22.37 Ea = 13.9 kJ mol−1 , A = 1.03 × 109 dm3 mol−1 s−1 . 22.39 k1 = 3.82 × 106 dm3 mol−1 s−1 , k2 = 5.1 × 105 dm3 mol−1 s−1 , k3 = 4.17 × 106 dm3 mol−1 s−1 , = 0.13. k2 k1 k1k2 k′1 D E F [A]0 + [B]0 2 A B C D E F A0 − 2x A0 − x A B C D E F 1 A0 2 A B C D E F 2x A0 2 (A0 − 2x) A B C 2x(A0 − x) A0 2 (A0 − 2x)2 f(4c*) f(c*) f(3c*) f(c*) (nc*)2 e−mn2 c*2 /2kT c*2 e−mc*2 /2kT f(nc*) f(c*) ͗ ͘h2 SOLUTIONS TO ODD PROBLEMS 1039 Chapter 23 23.3 (1) Initiation, (2), (3), (4) and (5) Propagation, (6) Termination. = 1/2 [N2O][SiH4]1/2 23.5 = . This simple rate law is observed when step (b) is rate-determining so that step (a) is a rapid equilibrium and [I·] is in an approximate steady state. This is equivalent to kb[H2] = ka′ and hence, = 2kbK[I2][H2]. 23.7 (a) τ0 = 6.67 ns; (b) kf = 0.105 ns−1 . 23.9 kq = 1.98 × 109 dm3 mol−1 s−1 . 23.13 δM = , δM = M{kt[A]0(1 + kt[A]0)}1/2 . 23.15 ͗n͘ = v = k[M][I]1/2 . 23.19 = −I − k2 1/2 [A]. 23.21 f = . 23.27 Uncompetitive. 23.29 R = 2.6 nm. 23.35 (a) Initiation, propagation, propagation, termination, initiation; (b) = −2ka[NO]2 − 2kb[O][NO]; (c) Ea,eff = Eb + 1 –2E−d − 1 –2Ed; (d) Ea,eff ≈ 381.39 kJ mol−1 ; (e) = −2kb 1/2 [NO]2 ; (f) = −2kb 1/2 [NO]2 , where ke is the rat constant for NO + O2 → O + NO2. Ea,eff = 253 kJ mol−1 , this value is consistent with the low range of the experimental values of Ea,eff. Chapter 24 24.1 (a) σ* = 4.4 × 10−20 m2 ; (b) P = 0.15. 24.3 k2 = 1.7 × 1011 M−1 s−1 , t = 3.6 ns. 24.5 2−. 24.9 (a) − = k1[F2O]2 + k2 1/2 [F2O]3/2 ; (b) ∆H(FO-F) ≈ E1 = 160.9 kJ mol−1 , ∆H(O-F) ≈ 224.4 kJ mol−1 , E2 ≈ 60 kJ mol−1 . 24.11 Linear regression analysis of ln(rate constant) against 1/T yields the following results: R = 0.999 76 and R = 0.998 48, which indicate that the data are a good fit. 24.15 P = 5.2 × 10−6 . 24.17 k1 = e−β∆E0, (a) D = 2.7 × 10−15 m2 s−1 , (b) D = 1.1 × 10−14 m2 s−1 . 24.23 For O2 with ethyl: P = 1.6 × 10−3 ; For O2 with cyclohexyl: P = 1.8 × 10−3 . v3 v ‡ 2 D E F k1 k4 A B C d[F2O] dt D E F ka 2kd[M] A B C d[NO] dt D E F ka 2kd[M] A B C d[NO] dt d[NO] dt k2k4[CO] k2[CO] + k3[M] D E F I k3 A B C d[A] dt p1/2 M 1 − p d[HI] dt 2kbka[I2][H2] k′a + kb[H2] d[HI] dt D E F k1k4k5 k6 A B C d[SiH4] dt 24.25 zA = +3.0. 24.27 Yes, the equation appears to apply, β = 13.4 nm−1 . Chapter 25 25.1 For a cation above a flat surface, the energy is 0.11. For a cation at the foot of a high cliff, the energy is −0.51. The latter is the more likely settling point. 25.3 (a) 1.61 × 1015 cm−2 ; (b) 1.14 × 1015 cm−2 ; (c) 1.86 × 1015 cm−2 . For the collision frequencies: Hydrogen Propane Z/(atom−1 s−1 ) 100 Pa 10−7 Torr 100 Pa 10−7 Torr (100) 6.8 × 105 8.7 × 10−2 1.4 × 105 1.9 × 10−2 (110) 9.6 × 105 1.2 × 10−1 2.0 × 105 2.7 × 10−2 (111) 5.9 × 105 7.5 × 10−2 1.2 × 105 1.7 × 10−2 25.5 (a) c = 164, Vmon13.1 cm3 ; (b) c = 264, Vmon12.5 cm3 . 25.7 c2 = 2.4, c1 = 0.16. 25.9 K = 0.138 mg g−1 , n = 0.58. 25.11 n∞ = 5.78 mol kg−1 , K = 7.02 Pa−1 . 25.13 j0/(mA cm−2 ) = 0.78, α = 0.38. 25.15 δ = 2.5 × 10−4 m or 0.25 mm. 25.21 (a) The Tafel plot of ln j against E show no region of lineraity so the Tafel equation cannot be used to determine j0 and α. 25.31 BET isotherm is a much better representation of the data. Vmon = 75.4 cm3 , c = 3.98. 25.33 (a) R values in the range 0.975 to 0.991, the fit is good at all temperatures. (b) ka = 3.68 × 10−3 , ∆adH = −8.67 kJ mol−1 , kb = 2.62 × 10−5 ppm−1 , ∆bH = −15.7 kJ mol−1 . (c) ka may be interpreted to be the maximum adsorption capacity at an adsorption enthalpy of zero, while kb is the maximum affinity in the case for which the adsorbant–surface bonding enthalpy is zero. 25.35 (a) K unit: (gR dm−3 )−1 [gR = mass (grams) of rubber], KF unit: (mg)(1−1/n) gR −1 dm−3/n , KL unit: (mg dm−3 )−1 , M unit: (mg gR −1 ). (b) R (Linear) = 0.9612, R (Freudlich) = 0.9682, R (Langmuir) = 0.9690, on this basis alone, the fits are equally satisfactory, but not good. The Langmuir isotherm can be eliminated as it gives a negative value for KL : the fit to the Freudlich isotherm has a large standard deviation. Hence the linear isotherm seems the best fit, but the Freudlich isotherm is preferred for this kind of system. (c) qrubber/qcharcoal = 0.164ceq −0.46 , hence much worse. 25.37 (a) Therefore, the metals with a thermodynamic tendency to corrode in moist conditions at pH = 7 are Fe, Al, Co, Cr if oxygen is absent, but, if oxygen is present, all seven elements have a tendency to corrode. (b) Ni: corrodes, Cd: corrodes, Mg: corrodes, Ti: corrodes, Mn: corrodes. 25.39 0.28 mg cm−2 d−1 . (T) denotes a table in the Data Section. A A2 spectrum 531 ab initio method 394 absolute value 963 absorbance 432 absorption spectroscopy 431 abundant-spin species 541 acceleration 981 acceleration of free fall 979 acceptable wavefunction 272 accommodation 917 acetaldehyde pyrolysis 830 achiral molecule 412 acid 763 acid catalysis 839 acidity constant 763, (T) 1007 acronyms 950 activated complex 809, 881 activated complex theory 880 activation, enthalpy of 51 activation energy 807, (T) 1023 composite reaction 822 negative 822 activation Gibbs energy (electrode) 935 activation-controlled reaction 877 active site 840 active transport 770 activity 158, 204 ion 163 activity coefficient 159 determination 228 additional work 34, 99 adiabat 48 adiabatic bomb calorimeter 38 adiabatic boundary 6 adiabatic demagnetization 568 adiabatic expansion 47, 48, 69 adiabatic flame calorimeter 42 adiabatic nuclear demagnetization 568 adiabatic process, entropy change 80 ADP 224, 225 adsorbate 909 adsorbent 909 adsorption 909 adsorption isotherm 917 adsorption rate 923 aerobic metabolism 225 aerosol 682 AES 914 AFM 289, 637 air, composition 11 Airy radius 466 all-trans-retinal 490 allowed transition 335, 435 alloy 175 microstructure 191 alpha-helix 677 alveoli 147 amount of substance 959 amplitude 982 anaerobic metabolism 225 angstrom 961 angular momentum 297, 981 commutator 307 magnitude 305 operator 307 orbital 326 quantization 298 summary of properties 309 total 349, 352 z-component 306 angular velocity 981 anharmonic 455 anharmonicity constant 455 anode 217 anodic current density 935 anti-parallel beta-sheet 678 anti-Stokes radiation 431 anti-bonding orbital 371 anticyclone 12 antiferromagnetic phase 736 antioxidant 386 antisymmetric stretch 461 antisymmetric wavefunction 338 apomyoglobin 819 aragonite 43 area 966 argon viscosity 760 argon-ion laser 507 aromatic stability 392 array detector 470 Arrhenius equation 807 Arrhenius parameters 807, 873, (T) 1021 ascorbic acid 386 asymmetric rotor 442 asymmetry potential 230 asymptotic solution 323 atmosphere 11, 462 temperature 463 temperature profile 854 atmosphere (unit) 4, 961 atmosphere composition 853 atmospheric ozone 855 atom 320 configuration 337 many-electron 336 selection rule 335 term symbol 352 atomic force microscopy 289, 637 atomic level 349 atomic orbital 326 atomic weight 959 atomization, enthalpy of 51 ATP 224, 858 attractive surface 890 Aufbau principle, see building-up principle 340 Auger electron spectroscopy 914 autocatalysis 803 autoprotolysis rate 806 avalanche photodiode 473 average molar mass 653 average value 528, 966 Avogadro’s principle 7 AX energy levels 524 AX2 spectrum 526 AX3 spectrum 526 Axilrod–Teller formula 636 axis of improper rotation 406 axis of symmetry 405 azeotrope 184 azimuth 301 B Balmer series 320 band formation 724 band gap 725 band head 487 band spectra 457 band width 725 bar 4, 961 barometer 4 barometric formula 12 barrier penetration 286 barrier transmission 287 base 763 base catalysis 840 base pairs 680 base-stacking 681 base unit 960 basis set 380 Bayard–Alpert pressure gauge 5 Beer–Lambert law 432 bends, the 147 benzene, MO description 391 Berthelot equation of state 19 BET isotherm 920 beta-barrel 679 beta-pleated sheet 678 beta-sheet 678 bilayer 686 bimolecular reaction 810 binomial coefficient 973 binomial expansion 571, 973 biochemical cascade 491 biofuel cell 948 biological standard state 161, 209 biosensor analysis 925 bipolaron 674 Birge–Sponer plot 456 bivariant 176 black body 245 black-body radiation 245 block-diagonal matrix 414 Blodgett, K. 687 blue sky 658 body-centred unit cell 699 Bohr frequency condition 249 Bohr magneton 514 Bohr model 360 Bohr radius 324 boiling 118 boiling point (T) 990 boiling point constant 151, (T) 1004 boiling temperature 118 Boltzmann distribution 81, 208, 563, 582 chemical equilibrium 212 Boltzmann formula 81, 575, 583 Boltzmann, L. 81 bond 362 bond dissociation energy 377 bond dissociation enthalpy 377, (T) 1011 bond enthalpy 55 bond length (T) 1011 determination 448 bond order 376 bond order correlations 377 bond torsion 676 bonding orbital 370 Born equation 102, 110 Born interpretation 256, 272 Born, M. 102, 256 Born–Mayer equation 719 Born–Haber cycle 719 Born–Oppenheimer approximation 363, 473 boson 309, 338 bouncing ball 77 bound state, hydrogen atom 326 boundary 5 boundary condition 278, 971 cyclic 298 boundary surface 329, 369 Boyle temperature 16 Boyle’s law 7 bra 313 bracket notation 313 Brackett series 321 Bragg, W. and L. 704 Bragg’s law 704 branch 458, 487 Index INDEX 1041 branching step 833 brass 131 Bravais lattice 699 breathing 147 Bremsstrahlung 702 Brønsted acid 763 Brønsted base 763 Brunauer, S. 920 bubble 642 buckminsterfullerene 410 building-up principle 340 bulk modulus 722 bumping 645 butadiene, MO description 389 C caesium-chloride structure 717 cage effect 876 calamitic liquid crystal 189 calcite 43 calorie 31, 979 calorimeter 38 calorimeter constant 38 calorimetry 38 camphor 628 candela 960 canonical distribution 578 canonical ensemble 577 canonical partition function 578 capacitance manometer 5 capillary action 643 capillary electrophoresis 664 capillary technique 778 carbon dioxide isotherm 15 phase diagram 120 supercritical 119 vibrations 461 carbon dioxide laser 507 carbon monoxide, residual entropy 610 carbon nanotube 728 carbonyl group 489 Carnot cycle 82 carotene 281, 398, 857 CARS 465 casein 682 catalyst 839 catalyst properties 930 catalytic constant 842 catalytic efficiency 842 catalytic hydrogenation 930 catalytic oxidation 930 cathode 217 cathodic current density 935 cathodic protection 950 cavity 642 CCD 473 ccp 716 CD spectra 491 cell, electrochemical 216 cell emf 219 cell notation 218 cell overpotential 944 cell potential 219 cell reaction 218 Celsius scale 6 centre of symmetry 406 centrifugal distortion 446 centrifugal distortion constant 446 centrifugal effect 323 ceramic 736 cesium, see caesium 717 CFC 855 chain carrier 830 chain polymerization 835, 836 chain reaction 830 chain relation 68, 968 chain rule 966 chain transfer 837 chain-branching explosion 833 channel former 770 Chapman model 855 character 413 character table 413, (T) 1023 characteristic rotational temperature 594 characteristic vibrational temperature 597 charge-coupled device 473 charge transfer rate 934 charge-transfer transition 489 Charles’s law 7 chemical equilibrium 208 Boltzmann distribution 208, 212 chemical exchange 532, 533 chemical kinetics 791 chemical potential 122 chemical equilibrium 201 general definition 138 significance 139 standard 141 variation with pressure 123 variation with temperature 123 chemical potential (band theory) 726 chemical potential gradient 772 chemical quench flow method 794 chemical shift 519 electronegativity 522 typical 520 chemiluminescence 886 chemiosmotic theory 227 chemisorption 917 chemisorption ability 929 chiral molecule 412, 491 chlorofluorocarbon 855 chlorophyll 856, 857 chloroplast 254, 856 cholesteric phase 189 cholesterol 687 chorine atom ozone decomposition 855 CHP system 947 chromatic aberration 490 chromatography 119 chromophore 487, (T) 1014 chromosphere 346 chronopotentiometry 940 circular dichroism 491 circular polarization 491 circularly birefringent 985 circularly polarized 984 circumstellar space 480 cis-retinal 490, 853 citric acid cycle 225, 856 Clapeyron equation 126 class 415, 416 classical mechanics 243 clathrate 635 Clausius inequality 86, 95 Clausius–Clapeyron equation 128 Clausius–Mossotti equation 627 Clebsch–Gordan series 352 close-packed 715 closed shell 339 closed system 28 cloud colour 658 cloud formation 645 CMC 685 CNDO 394 co-adsorption 926 coagulation 684 COBE 438 coefficient of performance 85 coefficient of thermal conductivity 758 coefficient of viscosity 758, 759, 785 cofactor (matrix) 976 coherence length 497 coherent anti-Stokes Raman spectroscopy 465 coherent radiation 497 colatitude 301 cold denaturation 819 collapse pressure 688 colligative property 150 collision 9, 753 elastic 748 reactive 886 collision cross-section 753, 870, (T) 1018 collision density 870 collision diameter 753 collision flux 755 collision frequency 753, 755 collision theory 809, 870 collision-induced emission 846 collisional deactivation 438, 846 collisional lifetime 438 colloid 682 colloid stability 683 colour 481, (T) 1013 column vector 976 combination difference 458 combination principle 321 combinatorial function 973 combined gas law 10 combined heat and power system 947 combustion, enthalpy of 51 common logarithm 963 commutator 271 angular momentum 307 commute 271 competitive inhibition 844 complementary observable 271 complete neglect of differential overlap 394 complete set 267 complete shell 339 complex conjugate 256, 963 complex mode process 891 complex number 256, 963 component 175 compound semiconductor 726 compressibility 722 compression factor 14, 111 Compton wavelength 316 computational chemistry 393 concentration cell 218 concentration polarization 941 concentration profile 878 condensation 17, 645 conductance 761 conducting polymer 674 conductivity 762 thermal 758 configuration atom 337 macromolecule 667 statistical 561 configuration integral 604 confocal microscopy 504 conformation 667 conformational conversion 532 conformational energy 675 conformational entropy 671 congruent melting 192 conjugated polyene 401 consecutive reactions 811 consolute temperature 186 constant acidity 763 anharmonicity 455 boiling point 151 calorimeter 38 centrifugal distortion 446 critical 16 dielectric 110 equilibrium 203 Faraday’s 985 force 452, 982 freezing point 153 gas 8 Lamé 743 Madelung 719 Michaelis 841 normalization 255 Planck’s 246 rotational 443 1042 INDEX Rydberg 320, 327 scalar coupling 524 second radiation 275 spin–orbit coupling 350 time 801 constituent 175 constrained chain 672 constructive interference 370 contact angle 644 continuum generation 503 contour diagram (reaction) 887 contour length 670 convection 12, 777 convective flux 777 cooling 86 cooling curve 178, 191 Cooper pair 737 cooperative transition 572 coordination 717 coordination number 716 core hamiltonian 393 Corey–Pauling rules 675 corona 346 correlation analysis 884 correlation diagram 355 correlation spectroscopy 543 corresponding states 21 corrosion 948 corrosion current 949 Cosmic Background Explorer 438 cosmic ray 244, 984 COSY 543 Coulomb integral 380 Coulomb interaction 986 Coulomb operator 393 Coulomb potential 110, 986 shielded 167 Coulomb potential energy 986 counter electrode 939 covalent bond 362 covalent network solid 720 cracking 931 cream 682 critical compression factor 21 critical constant 16, 17 critical field 737 critical isotherm 15 critical micelle concentration 685 critical molar volume 17 critical point 17 critical pressure 17, 118 critical solution temperature 186 critical temperature 17, 118 cross-peaks 546 cross-product 965 cross-relation 900, 903 cross-section 753, 870 state-to-state 887 crossed-beam technique 648 crossed molecular beams 886 cryogenics 568 crystal diode 473 crystal structure 697, 715 crystal system 698 crystallinity 673 crystallographic point group 408 crystallography 711 cubic close packed 716 cubic F 716 cubic group 410 cubic unit cell 698 cumulative reaction probability 891 Curie law 734 Curie temperature 736 current 987 current density 909 curvature 264 curved surface 643 CW spectrometer 520 cyclic boundary condition 301 cyclic voltammetry 943 cyclone 12 cytochrome 228 cytosol 771 D d block 342 D lines 351 d orbital 334 d orbital hybridization 367 d–d transition 484, 487 d-metal complex 488 Dalton’s law 13, 179 Daniell cell 218 dark current 473 Davisson, C. 252 Davisson–Germer experiment 252 Davydov splitting 730 de Broglie relation 252, 278 de Broglie wavelength 570 de Broglie, L. 252 Debye equation 627 Debye extrapolation 91 Debye formula 248 Debye length 168 Debye T3 law 91 Debye temperature 248 Debye, P. 248, 703 Debye–Hückel limiting law 164 Debye–Hückel theory 164, 167, 222 Debye–Hückel–Onsager coefficient (T) 1019 Debye–Hückel–Onsager theory 769 decomposition vapour pressure 206 defect surface 910 definite integral 966 degeneracy 416 rotational 445 degenerate 286 degenerate orbital 334 degradation 668 degree of conversion 572 degree of deprotonation 763 degree of dissociation 207, 211 degree of freedom 176 degree of ionization 763 degree of polymerization 835 delocalization energy 390 delta scale 519 denaturation 198, 668, 681, 819 density (T) 990 density functional theory 397 density of states 245, 744 depolarization 464 depression of freezing point 151 derivative 966 derived unit 960 derived units 961 Derjaguin, B. 683 deshielded nucleus 519 desorption 909 desorption rate 923 destructive interference 372 detection period 543 detector 471, 473 determinant 382, 975 deuterium lamp 470 DFT 395 diagonal peaks 546 dialysis 155, 712 diamagnetic 377, 734 diamagnetic contribution 521 diamond structure 720 diamond-anvil cell 178 diathermic boundary 5 diatomic molecule (T) 1013 diatomic molecule spectra 482 dielectric 619 dielectric constant 110, (T) 1004 Dieterici equation of state 19 differential 968 differential equation 811, 971 differential overlap 394 differential pulse voltammetry 943 differential scanning calorimeter 46 differential scattering cross-section 640 differentiation 966 diffraction 702 diffraction grating 471 diffraction limit 466 diffraction order 471 diffraction pattern 702 diffractometer 703 diffuse double layer 933 diffusion 747, 757, 772, 776 reaction 877, 879 relation to curvature 777 relation to mobility 774 diffusion coefficient 758, 759, 784, (T) 1016 viscosity 775 diffusion equation 877 diffusion-controlled limit 877 dihelium 373 dilute-spin species 541 diode laser 732 dioxygen, electronic states 483 dipole 620 dipole moment 620, (T) 1015 induced 624 measurement 446 dipole–charge interaction 629 dipole–dipole interaction 631, 646 dipole–dipole interaction (EPR) 553 dipole–induced dipole interaction 633 Dirac bracket notation 313 direct method 710 direct mode process 891 direct product decomposition 420 discotic liquid crystal 189 dismutation 385 disorder 81 disperse phase 682 dispersing element 432, 471 dispersion 81, 175, 985 dispersion interaction 633, 677 disproportionation 837 dissociation 495 degree of 207, 211 dissociation energy 363 determination 456 dissociation equilibrium 612 dissociation limit 495 distillation 182 partially miscible liquids 187 distinguishable molecules 580 distortion polarization 626 distribution of speeds 749 disulfide bond 681 DNA 652, 680 analysis 664 damage 855 intercalation 638 structure from X-rays 711 Dogonadze, R.R. 896 donor–acceptor pair 852 dopant 726 doping 191 Doppler broadening 436 Doppler effect 361, 436 dot product 350, 514, 965 drift speed 661, 765, 774 droplet 642 drug design 638 dry air 11 DSC 42 duality 253 Dulong and Petit law 247 Dulong, P.-L. 247 dust grain 438 DVLO theory 684 dye laser 508 dynamic light scattering 660 dynode 473 E Eadie–Hofstee plot 867 Earth surface temperature 463 INDEX 1043 eddy 11 edible fat 930 EELS 913 effect 769 cage 876 centrifugal 323 Doppler 361, 436 electrophoretic 769 Joule–Thomson 64 kinetic isotope 816 kinetic salt 885 Meissner 737 photoelectric 250 relaxation 769 salting-in 173 salting-out 173 Stark 446 effective mass 453 effective nuclear charge 339, (T) 1009 effective potential energy 323 effective transverse relaxation time 538 efficiency 83, 585 effusion 747 Ehrenfest classification 129 Ehrenfest equations 134 eigenfunction 262 eigenvalue 262 eigenvalue equation 261, 977 eigenvector 977 Einstein, A. 247 Einstein coefficient 434 Einstein formula 602 Einstein formula (heat capacity) 247 Einstein relation 774 Einstein temperature 247 Einstein–Smoluchowski equation 782 elastic collision 9 elastic deformation 720 elastic limit 723 elastomer 673 electric conduction 747 electric dipole 620 electric field 244, 631, 983 electric field strength 987 electric potential 110 electrical conductivity, temperature dependence 726 electrical double layer 683, 932 electrical heating 38 electrical power 38, 987 electro-osmotic drag 948 electroactive species 909 electrochemical cell 216 electrochemical correlations 397 electrochemical potential 952 electrochemical series 224 electrode 216 counter 939 reference 939 varieties 216 working 939 electrode compartment 216 electrode concentration cell 218 electrode potential 941, 952 electrode process 932 electrode, varieties of 216 electrode–surface interface 932 electrodialysis 683 electrokinetic potential 683 electrolysis 944 electrolyte 216, 762 electrolyte concentration cell 218 electrolytic cell 216 electromagnetic field 243, 983 electromagnetic radiation 491 electromagnetic spectrum 244, 984 electromotive force 219 electron, magnetic moment 514 electron affinity 344 periodicity 344 electron affinity (T) 1010 electron density 396, 708 electron diffraction 252, 714 electron energy loss spectroscopy 913 electron gain electrical 51 enthalpy of 51 electron in magnetic field 514 electron interaction integrals 371 electron microscopy 253 electron pair 337 electron pair formation 364 electron paramagnetic resonance 516, 549 electron scattering factor 742 electron spectroscopy for chemical analysis 913 electron spin resonance 516, 549 electron transfer between proteins 900 reaction 853, 894 electron-gain enthalpy 343 electronegativity 379, (T) 1012 electronic partition function 597 electronic polarizability 626 electronic structure 320 electronvolt 961 electrophoresis 663 electrophoretic effect 769 electrostatic potential surface 396 electrostatics 985 elementary reaction 809 elevation of boiling point 150 Eley–Rideal mechanism 928 Ellingham diagram 215 elpot surface 396 emf 219 temperature variation 231 emission spectroscopy 431 Emmett, P. 920 emulsification 683 emulsion 682 end separation (polymer) 669 endergonic 202 endothermic process 29 energy 29, 979 conformational 675 electron in magnetic field 514 harmonic oscillator 291 multipole interaction 630 nucleus in magnetic field 515 particle in a box 280 quantization 246, 260 rotational 443 zero-point 281 energy density 755 energy dispersal 77 energy flux 757 energy pooling 846 ensemble 577 enthalpy 40 electron gain 343 ionization 343 partition function 590 reaction 212 variation with temperature 46 enthalpy and entropy, relation between 44 enthalpy density 53 enthalpy of activation 51, 883 enthalpy of atomization 51 enthalpy of chemisorption 917, (T) 1022 enthalpy of combustion 51, 52 enthalpy of electron gain 51, 343 enthalpy of formation 51 enthalpy of fusion 50, (T) 993 enthalpy of hydration 51 enthalpy of ionization 51, 343 enthalpy of mixing 51, 143 enthalpy of physisorption 917, (T) 1022 enthalpy of reaction 51 enthalpy of solution 51 enthalpy of sublimation 51 enthalpy of transition 50 notation 51 enthalpy of vaporization 49, 50, (T) 993 entropy Boltzmann formula 575 conformational 671 excess 149 from Q 579 harmonic oscillator 576 internal energy 589 measurement 91 partial molar 94 partition function 589 reaction 93 residual 93, 609 statistical 575 statistical definition 80 thermodynamic definition 78 Third-Law 93, 575 two-level system 576 units 79 variation with temperature 89 entropy change adiabatic process 80 heating 89 perfect gas expansion 79 phase transition 87 surroundings 79 entropy determination 91 entropy of activation 883 entropy of mixing 143 entropy of transition (T) 1002 entropy of vaporization 88, (T) 1003 enzyme 839, 840 epifluorescence 504 EPR 516, 549 EPR spectrometer 549 equation Arrhenius 807 Born 102, 110 Born–Mayer 719 Clapeyron 126 Clausius–Clapeyron 128 Clausius–Mossotti 627 Debye 627 differential 971 diffusion 776 eigenvalue 261, 977 Einstein–Smoluchowski 782 Eyring 882 fundamental 139 generalized diffusion 777 Gibbs–Duhem 140 Gibbs–Helmholtz 105 Hartree–Fock 393 Karplus 528 Margules 162 Mark–Kuhn–Houwink–Sakurada 666 material balance 879 McConnell 552 Michaelis–Menten 841 Nernst 221 Nernst–Einstein 775 partial differential 973 Poisson’s 168, 986 Roothaan 393 Sackur–Tetrode 580 secular 380, 977 Stern–Volmer 849 Stokes–Einstein 775, 878 Thomson 127 transcendental 186 van der Waals 17 van ’t Hoff 156, 212, 919 virial 16 Wierl 742 equation of state 3 partition function 604 thermodynamic 104 equilibrium 35 approach to 804 Boltzmann distribution 208, 212 1044 INDEX chemical 201 effect of compression 211 effect of temperature 211 mechanical 4 response to pressure 210 sedimentation 662 thermal 6 thermodynamic criterion 122 equilibrium bond length 363 equilibrium constant 203 contributions to 613 electrochemical prediction 228 molecular interpretation 208 partition function 611 relation between 208 relation to rate constant 804 standard cell emf 221 standard Gibbs energy of reaction 206 thermodynamic 205 equilibrium table 207 equipartition theorem 31, 247, 600 equivalent nuclei 526, 530 ER mechanism 928 error function 297 error function (T) 1009 ESCA 913 escape depth 912 ESR 516, 549 essential symmetry 699 ethanal pyrolysis 830 ethanol 396 ethene, MO description 387 Euler chain relation 68, 968 eutectic 191 eutectic halt 192 evanescent wave 925 evolution period 543 exact differential 58, 968 criterion for 103 excess entropy 149 excess function 149 exchange–correlation energy 395 exchange–correlation potential 395 exchange current density 937, (T) 1023 exchange operator 393 exchange process 532 excimer formation 846 exciplex laser 507 excited state absorption 846 excited state decay 848 exciton 304, 729 exciton band 730 excluded volume 18 exclusion principle 337 exclusion rule 464 exercise 53 exergonic 202 exocytosis 687 exothermic process 29 exp-6 potential 637 expansion coefficient 62, (T) 1002 expansion work 33 expectation value 267, 974 explosion 833 exponential decay 799 exponential function 963 extended Debye–Hückel law 165 extensive property 31, 959 extent of reaction 201, 794 extinction coefficient 432 extra work, see additional work 34 extrinsic semiconductor 726 eye 490 Eyring equation 882 F f block 342 face-centred cubic 716 face-centred unit cell 699 factorial 967 far infrared 244 far-field confocal microscopy 504 fat 53 fcc 716 FEMO 401 femtochemistry 892 femtosecond spectroscopy 893 Fermi calculation 790 Fermi contact interaction 528 Fermi level 725 fermion 309, 338 Fermi–Dirac distribution 726 ferrocene 411 ferromagnetism 736 fibre 673 Fick’s first law of diffusion 757, 773 Fick’s second law of diffusion 776 FID 535, 554 field 244 electric 244, 983 electromagnetic 243, 983 magnetic 244, 983 field-ionization microscopy 924 FIM 924 fine structure atomic 351 fine structure (NMR) 524 finite barrier 288 first ionization energy 342 First Law of thermodynamics 32 first-order correction 310 first-order differential equation 811 first-order phase transition 129 first-order reaction 796, 798 first-order spectra 532 flash desorption 916 flash photolysis 793 flocculation 684 flow method 793 fluctuations 578 fluid mosaic model 687 fluorescence 492, 846 laser-induced 886 solvent effect 493 fluorescence lifetime 848 fluorescence microscopy 494 fluorescence quantum yield 848 fluorescence resonance energy transfer 852 flux 757 toward electrode 941 Fock operator 393 Fock, V. 344 food, energy reserves 52 forbidden transition 335, 435 force 637, 980 between charges 986 generalized 34 thermodynamic 772 force constant 290, 452 force field 462 formal potential 941 formaldehyde synthesis 860 formation 204 enthalpy of 51 formula unit 959 Förster theory 852, 863 Förster, T. 852 four-centred integral 395 four-circle diffractometer 704 four-helix bundle 678 Fourier transform 554 Fourier transform technique 432, 471 Fourier-transform NMR 533 fractional coverage 916 fractional distillation 183 fracture 723 framework representation 931 Franck–Condon factor 486 Franck–Condon principle 484, 493 Franklin, R. 711 free energy, see Gibbs energy 98 free expansion 34 free particle 277 free-electron molecular orbital theory 401 free-induction decay 535 freely jointed chain 75, 668 freeze quench method 794 freezing point constant 153, (T) 1004 freezing temperature 120 Frenkel exciton 729 frequency 244, 983 frequency-domain signal 536 frequency doubling 732 FRET 852 Freundlich isotherm 922 frictional coefficient 660, (T) 1017 Friedrich, W. 702 frontier orbital 388 FT-NMR 533 fuel, thermochemical properties 53 fuel cell 947 fuel-rich regime 834 fugacity 111 fugacity coefficient 111 full rotation group 411 functional 395, 969 functional derivative 395, 969 functional MRI 541 fundamental equation 103, 139 fundamental transition 455 fusion, enthalpy of 50 G g subscript 372 g-value 514, 550 Galileo 4 Galvani potential 952 Galvani potential difference 932, 934 galvanic cell 216 working 945 galvanizing 949 gamma-ray region 244, 984 gas 3 kinetic model 9 gas constant 8 gas laser 506 gas laws 7 gas mixture 12 gas solubility 147 gas solvation 124 gas-sensing electrode 230 gauss 514 Gaussian function 292 Gaussian-type orbital 395 gel 682 gel electrophoresis 664 general solution 971 generalized diffusion equation 777 generalized displacement 34 generalized force 34 genomics 664 gerade symmetry 372 Gerlach, W. 307 Germer. 248 GFP 494 Gibbs energy 96 formation 100 maximum non-expansion work 99 mixing 142 mixing (partial miscibility) 186 partial molar 138 partition function 591 perfect gas 107 properties 105 reaction 100, 201 solvation 110 standard reaction 202, 220 surface 688 variation with pressure 106 variation with temperature 105 Gibbs energy of activation 883 INDEX 1045 Gibbs energy of activation (electron transfer) 903 Gibbs energy of formation 204 Gibbs energy of mixing, ideal solution 148 Gibbs energy of reaction 100 Gibbs isotherm 689 Gibbs, J.W. 176 Gibbs–Duhem equation 140 Gibbs–Helmholtz equation 105 glancing angle 704 glass electrode 229 glass transition temperature 674 global warming 462 globar 470 glucose oxidation 226 glycolysis 225 Gouy balance 734 Gouy–Chapman model 933 Grahame model 933 Graham’s law of effusion 756 grand canonical ensemble 577 graphical representation 396 graphite structure 720 gravimetry 916 green fluorescent protein 494 greenhouse effect 462 gross selection rule 436 Grotrian diagram 336 Grotthuss mechanism 766 group theory 404 GTO 395 Gunn oscillator 550 H haematoporphyrin 861 hair 681 half-life 800, (T) 1020 summary 803 half-reaction 216 hamiltonian core 393 Hückel method 388 hydrogen molecule-ion 368 hamiltonian matrix 389 hamiltonian operator 261 hard sphere packing 716 hard-sphere potential 637 harmonic motion 290 harmonic oscillator 291 energy 291 entropy 576 penetration 296 wavefunction 291 harmonic oscillator (classical) 982 harmonic wave 983 Harned cell 222 harpoon mechanism 875 Hartree, D.R. 344 Hartree–Fock equations 393 Hartree–Fock self-consistent field 344 hcp 715, 716 heat 29 heat and work equivalence of 32 heat at constant pressure 41 heat capacity 39, 247, (T) 992 constant pressure 45 constant volume 38, 39 contributions summary 616, 620 molar 45 partition function 601 phase transition 130 relation between 63, 69 relation between (perfect gas) 47 rotational transitions 602 specific 39 variation with temperature 46 vibrational contribution 602 heat capacity ratio 48 heat engine 76 efficiency 83 Heisenberg uncertainty principle 269, 272 Heisenberg, W. 269 helium 337 Grotrian diagram 348 helium-neon laser 506 helix scattering 711 helix–coil transition 571, 818 Helmholtz energy 96 molecular interpretation 97 partition function 590 Helmholtz layer model 932 Henry, W. 145 Henry’s law 145 Henry’s law constant (T) 1003 Hermann–Mauguin system 406 Hermite polynomial 292 hermitian operator 264, 283 hermiticity 313 Hertz 244 Hess’s law 53 heterogeneous catalysis 927 rate law 927 heterogeneous catalyst 839 heterogeneous reaction rate 795 heteronuclear diatomic molecule, MO description 368, 379 heteronuclear spin system 532 hexagonal unit cell 699 hexagonally close-packed 715 HF-SCF 344 high-energy phosphate bond 225 high-performance liquid chromatography 119 high-temperature superconductor 736 highest occupied molecular orbital 388 Hinshelwood, C.N. 820 HOMO 388 homogeneity index 654 homogeneous catalyst 839 homogenized milk 682 homonuclear diatomic molecule MO description 368 molecular orbital diagram 375 VB description 363 homonuclear spin system 532 Hooke’s law 673 HPLC 119 HREELS 913 HTSC 736 Hückel approximations 387 Hückel method 387 Hückel, E. 387 Hull, A. 703 Humphreys series 359 Hund’s maximum multiplicity rule 341 Hush, N.S. 896 hybrid orbital 366 hybridization 366 hybridization schemes 368 hydration, enthalpy of 51 hydrodynamic flow 647 hydrodynamic radius 766 hydrofluorocarbon 856 hydrogen atom bound state 326 energies 324 wavefunction 324 hydrogen bond 634, 677 hydrogen–bromine reaction 831, 860 hydrogen electrode 222 hydrogen fluoride, MO description 379, 384 hydrogen ion conduction by 766 enthalpy of formation 55 Gibbs energy of formation 100 standard entropy 94 hydrogen molecule MO description 373 VB description 364 hydrogen molecule ion 368 hydrogen–oxygen reaction 833 hydrogen peroxide decomposition 839 hydrogen storage 947 hydrogen/oxygen fuel cell 947 hydrogenation 929 hydrogenic atom 320 hydrogenic orbital, mean radius 330 hydronium ion 766 hydrophilic 682 hydrophobic 635, 682 hydrophobic interaction 636 hydrophobicity constant 635 hydrostatic pressure 5 hydrostatic stress 721 hyperbola 7 hyperfine coupling constant 551, (T) 1015 hyperfine structure 551 hyperpolarizability 732 hypertonic 155 I IC 495, 846 ice 121 phase diagram 121 residual entropy 93, 610 structure 121, 721 icosahedral group 410 ideal gas, see perfect gas 8 ideal solution 144 Gibbs energy of mixing 148 ideal–dilute solution 146 identity operation 405 IHP 933 immiscible liquids 184 impact parameter 640 impressed-current cathodic protection 950 improper rotation 406 incident beam flux 648 incongruent melting 193 indefinite integral 966 independent migration of ions 763 independent molecules 579 indicator diagram 35 indicator solution 768 indistinguishable molecules 580 induced dipole moment 624 induced fit model 840 induced magnetic moment 736 induced-dipole–induced-dipole interaction 633 induction period 812 inelastic neutron scattering 761 inexact differential 58 infectious disease kinetics 867 infinite temperature 567, 584 infrared 244 infrared active 454 infrared activity 467 infrared chemiluminescence 886 infrared inactive 454 infrared region 984 inhibition 844 inhomogeneous broadening 538 initial condition 971 initiation step 831 inner Helmholtz plane 933 inner potential 934 insulator 723 integral 966 integral protein 687 integrated absorption coefficient 433 integrated rate law 798 summary 803 integrated signal 521 integration 966 integration by parts 967 intensive property 959 interference 251, 370 1046 INDEX interferogram 472 interferometer 471 intermolecular interaction 14 internal conversion 495 internal energy 30 fluid 609 from Q 578 general changes in 59 heat at constant volume 37 molecular contributions 31 partition function 573 properties 103 statistical 573 internal pressure 60 International System (point groups) 406 International System (units) 960 interstellar cloud 439 intersystem crossing 494 intrinsic semiconductor 726 intrinsic viscosity 665, (T) 1017 inverse matrix 976 inversion operation 406 inversion recovery technique 538 inversion symmetry 372 inversion temperature 66, (T) 1002 inverted region 899 iodine, metallic 178 ion activity 163 Gibbs energy of formation 101 standard entropy 94 ion channel 770 ion mobility 765, 774 ion pump 770 ion-selective electrode 229 ionic atmosphere 164, 683, 769 ionic bond 362 ionic mobility (T) 1019 ionic radius (T) 1017 ionic solid 717 ionic strength 164 ionization, enthalpy of 51, 343 ionization energy 327, 342, (T) 1010 periodicity 343 spectroscopic measurement 325 ion–ion interaction (conductivity) 769 irreducible representation 415 irrep 415 ISC 494, 846 isenthalpic process 64 isobar 10, 12 isobaric calorimeter 41 isochore 10 isodensity surface 396 isoelectric focusing 665 isoelectric point 665 isolated system 29 isolation method 797 isopleth 181 isosteric enthalpy of adsorption 919 isotherm 7, 10, 15 isothermal compressibility 62, (T) 1002 isothermal expansion 79 isothermal Joule–Thomson coefficient 65 isothermal reversible expansion 36 isotope abundance (T) 991 isotope separation 501 isotopomer 501 J Jablonski diagram 495 Jeans, J. 245 jj-coupling 355 joule 31, 961, 979 Joule experiment 60 Joule, J.P. 31, 60 Joule–Thomson coefficient 63, (T) 1002 Joule–Thomson effect 64 K K-radiation 703 Karplus equation 528 Kassel form 821 Kassel, L.S. 821 Keesom interaction 632 kelvin 6 Kelvin equation 645 Kelvin scale 6 Kelvin statement 76 keratin 681 Kerr lens 733 Kerr medium 733 ket 313 kinetic chain length 838 kinetic control 815 kinetic energy 9, 979 kinetic energy density 755 kinetic energy operator 264 kinetic isotope effect 816 kinetic model 747 kinetic model of gas 9 kinetic pressure 609 kinetic theory, transport properties 758 Kirchhoff’s law 56 klystron 550 KMT, see kinetic model 747 Knipping, P. 702 Knudsen method 756 Kohlrausch’s law 762 Kohn–Sham equations 395 Koopmans’ theorem 378 Krafft temperature 685 Kronecker delta 311, 975 krypton-ion laser 507 L Lagrange method 582, 970 Laguerre polynomial 324 Lamb formula 521 lambda line 121, 122 lambda-transition 130 Lamé constants 743 lamellar micelle 685 laminar flow 758 lamp 470 Landau, L. 683 Langevin function 624 Langmuir isotherm 918 Langmuir, I. 687 Langmuir–Blodgett film 687 Langmuir–Hinshelwood mechanism 927 Laplace equation 643 laplacian 168, 255, 301 Laporte selection rule 483 Larmor frequency 515, 534 laser 732 laser action 496 laser radiation characteristics 500 laser-induced fluorescence 886 lattice energy 718 lattice enthalpy (T) 1018 lattice point 698 law Beer–Lambert 432 Boyle’s 7 Charles’s 7 combined gas 10 cosines 370 Curie 734 Dalton’s 13, 179 Debye T3 91 Debye–Hückel limiting 164 Dulong and Petit 247 extended Debye-Hückel 165 Fick’s first 757, 773 Fick’s second 776 First 32 gas 7 Graham’s 756 Henry’s 145 Hess’s 53 Hooke’s 673, 723 Kirchhoff’s 56 Kohlrausch’s 762 limiting 7 motion 981 Newton’s second 981 Ostwald’s dilution 764 Raoult’s 144, 179 Rayleigh–Jeans 245 Second 76 Stefan–Boltzmann 275 Stokes’ 775 Third 93 Wien’s 275 Zeroth 6 law of cosines 370, 964 LCAO-MO 369, 374, 386 symmetry considerations 424 LCAO-MO (solids) 724 Le Chatelier, H. 210 Le Chatelier’s principle 210 LED 732 LEED 914 legendrian 255, 301 Lennard-Jones parameters (T) 1016 Lennard-Jones potential 637 level atomic 349 energies 350 lever rule 181 levitation 737 Lewis, G.N. 362 LFER 884, 899 LH mechanism 927 lifetime 437 rotational state 462 lifetime broadening 438 ligand-field splitting parameter 488 ligand-to-metal transition 489 light 242, 481 light (T) 1013 light-emitting diode 732 light harvesting 856 light harvesting complex 856 light-induced photoisomerization 713 light scattering 657, 691 limiting current density 942 limiting ionic conductivity (T) 1019 limiting law 7, 164 limiting molar conductivity 762 limiting transport number 768 Linde refrigerator 66 Lindemann, F. (Lord Cherwell) 820 Lindemann–Hinshelwood mechanism 820 line alternation 451 line broadening (NMR) 532 line intensity 517 line shape 436 linear combination 267 degenerate orbital 334 linear combination of atomic orbitals 369, 374, 386 linear free energy relation 884, 899 linear momentum, wavefunction 261 linear rotor 442, 445 linear-sweep voltammetry 942 Lineweaver–Burk plot 842 lipid bilayer 779 lipid raft model 687 liposome 685 liquid, molecular motion 761 liquid crystal 191, 685 phase diagram 192 liquid crystal display 189 liquid junction potential 218 liquid structure 606 liquid viscosity 761 liquid–liquid phase diagram 185 liquid–solid phase diagram 189 INDEX 1047 liquid–vapour boundary 127 lithium atom 337 litre 961 LMCT 489 local contribution to shielding 521 local density approximation 396 local minima 677 lock-and-key model 840 logarithm 963 London formula 635 London interaction 633 long-range order 606 longitudinal relaxation time 536 low energy electron diffraction 914 low overpotential limit 938 low temperature 85 lower critical solution temperature 186 lowest occupied molecular orbital 388 Luggin capillary 939 LUMO 388 lung 147 Lyman series 320 lyophilic 682 lyophobic 682 lyotropic liquid crystal 189 lyotropic mesomorph 685 M macromolecule 652 macular pigment 490 Madelung constant 719 magic-angle spinning 549 magnetic field 244, 983 magnetic flux density 734 magnetic induction 514 magnetic levitation 737 magnetic moment 514, 735 magnetic quantum number 302 magnetic resonance imaging 540 magnetic susceptibility 522, (T) 1018 magnetically equivalent nuclei 530 magnetizability 734 magnetization 733 magnetization vector 534 magnetogyric ratio 514 MALDI 655 MALDI-TOF 655 manometer 5, 24 many-electron atom 320, 336 Marcus cross-relation 903 Marcus inverted region 899 Marcus theory 853, 896 Marcus, R.A. 821, 896 Margules equation 162 Mark–Kuhn–Houwink–Sakurada equation 666 Mars van Kreelen mechanism 930 MAS 549 mass spectrometry 655 material balance equation 879 matrix addition 975 matrix algebra 975 matrix diagonalization 389 matrix element 310, 313, 975 matrix-assisted laser desorption/ ionization 655 matter flux 757 matter, nature of 309 maximum multiplicity 341 maximum velocity 840 maximum work 96 Maxwell construction 20 Maxwell distribution 750 Maxwell relation 104 Mayer f-function 605 MBE 728 MBRS 928 MBS 916 McConnell equation 552 mean activity coefficient 163, (T) 1004 mean bond enthalpy 55, (T) 1012 mean cubic molar mass 653 mean displacement 294 mean distance diffused 781 mean energies summary 616 mean energy 599 mean free path 754 mean molar mass 653 mean radius, hydrogenic orbital 330 mean rotational energy 600 mean speed 751, 752 mean square displacement 294 mean square molar mass 653 mean translational energy 600 mean value 528, 974 mean value theorem 967 mean vibrational energy 600 measurement, interpretation 267 mechanical equilibrium 4 mechanical property 721 mechanism of reaction 791 Meissner effect 737 melting, response to pressure 123 melting point (T) 990 melting temperature 119 melting temperature (polymer) 674 membrane formation 685 transport across 779 mercury photosensitization 860 meridional scattering 711 meso-tartaric acid 407 mesopause 854 mesophase 189 mesosphere 854 metal extraction 215 metal-to-ligand transition 489 metallic conductor 723 metallic lustre 730 metastable excited state 496 metastable phase 118 methane, VB description 365 method of initial rates 797 method of undetermined multipliers 582 mho 762 micelle 685 Michaelis constant 841 Michaelis–Menten equation 841 Michaelis–Menten mechanism 841 Michelson interferometer 432, 471 microcanonical ensemble 577 microporous material 931 microstructure 191 microwave background radiation 438 microwave region 244, 984 Mie potential 637 milk 682 Miller indices 700 mirror plane 406 Mitchell, P. 228 mitochondrion 225 mixed inhibition 845 mixing enthalpy of 51 role in equilibrium 203 MLCT 489 mmHg 4 MO 368 MO theory 362 mobility 765 mobility on surface 924 mode locking 499 mode-selective chemistry 893 model Bohr 360 Chapman 855 Gouy–Chapman 933 Grahame 933 Helmholtz 932 kinetic 9, 747 RRK 821, 824 RRKM 821 Zimm–Bragg 572 zipper 572 moduli 721 modulus 963 molality 140, 960 molar absorption coefficient 432 molar concentration 140, 960 molar conductivity 762 diffusion coefficient 775 molar heat capacity 45 molar magnetic susceptibility 734 molar mass 653 molar mss 959 molar partition function 591 molar polarization 627 molar property 959 molar volume 959 molarity 140, 960 mole 959 mole fraction 13 molecular beam 640, 647 molecular beam epitaxy 728 molecular beam scattering 916 molecular beams 886 molecular cloud 439 molecular collision 753 molecular dynamics 607, 677 molecular flow 647 molecular interaction 14 molecular interpretation equilibrium constant 208 heat and work 29 molecular mechanics 677 molecular modelling 56 molecular orbital 368 molecular orbital energy level diagram 373 molecular orbital theory 362, 368 molecular partition function 564, 591 molecular potential energy curve 363 hydrogen molecule-ion 371 molecular recognition 638 molecular scattering 641 molecular solid 720 molecular spectroscopy 430 molecular speed, distribution of 750 molecular vibration 452 symmetry 467 molecular weight, see molar mass 653, 959 molecularity 810 molten globule 198 moment of inertia 297, 441, 981 momentum flux 758 momentum operator 263 momentum representation 276 monochromatic source 470 monochromator 471 monoclinic unit cell 698, 699 monodisperse 653 monolayer 687 monomer 652 monopole 630 Monte Carlo method 607 Morse potential energy 455 most probable radius 332 most probable speed 752 mouse cell 466 moving boundary method 768 MPI 886 MRI 540 Mulliken electronegativity 380, (T) 1012 multi-walled nanotube 720 multinomial coefficient 562, 974 multiphoton ionization 886 multiphoton process 500 multiple quantum transition 547 multiplicity 353, 482 multipole 630 multipole interaction energy 630 mutual termination 837 MWNT 720 1048 INDEX N n-fold rotation 405 n-pole 630 n-type semiconductivity 727 NADH 225 NADP 857, 858 nanocrystal 304 nanodevice 690, 728 nanofabrication 690 nanoscience 288 nanotechnology 288, 289 nanotube 720, 728 nanowire 728 narcosis 147 natural linewidth 438 natural logarithm 963 Nd-YAG laser 731 near infrared region 984 near-field optical microscopy 504 nearly free-electron approximation 724 negative phototactic response 713 negative temperature 584 neighbouring group contribution 521, 522 nematic phase 189 neodymium laser 731 neon atom 341 Nernst diffusion layer 941 Nernst equation 221 Nernst filament 470 Nernst heat theorem 92 Nernst–Einstein equation 775 network solid 720 neutron diffraction 713 neutron magnetic scattering 714 neutron scattering 761 newton 961 Newtonian flow 758 Newton’s second law of motion 981 nicotine 186 nitric oxide 386 electronic partition function 598 magnetism 744 nitrogen fugacity (T) 1003 VB description 364 nitrogen fixation 385 nitrogen laser 507 nitrogen narcosis 147 NMR 517 line intensity 517 spectrometer 517 nodal plane 333 node 261 NOE 542 NOESY 548 non-Arrhenius behaviour 817 non-competitive inhibition 845 non-polarizable electrode 940 nonexpansion work 34 nonlinear phenomena 732 nonradiative decay 492 normal boiling point 118 normal freezing point 120 normal melting point 120 normal mode 461 group theory 467 infrared activity 467 normal transition temperature 87 normal Zeeman effect 360 normalization 258, 278, 279 normalization constant 257 notation orbital 421 notational conventions 962 NSOM 504 nuclear g-factor 516 nuclear magnetic resonance 517 nuclear magneton 516 nuclear Overhauser effect 542 nuclear spin 515, (T) 1014 nuclear constitution 515 properties 516 nuclear spin quantum number 515 nuclear statistics 451 nucleation 645 nucleation step 572 nucleic acid 679 nuclide abundance (T) 991 nuclide mass (T) 991 number-average molar mass 653 numerical integration 972 nylon-66 673, 835 O O branch 459 oblate 444 observable 262, 272 complementary 271 octahedral complex 488 octane 53 octupole 631 off-diagonal peaks 546 OHP 932 oil hydrogenation 930 one-component system 177 one-dimensional crystal 718 one-dimensional random walk 781 open system 28 operator 261, 272 angular momentum 307 Coulomb 393 exchange 393 hermitian 264, 283 kinetic energy 264 momentum 263 position 263 potential energy 263 optical activity 985 optical density 432 optical Kerr effect 733 optical trapping 568 optically active 412 orbital anti-bonding 371 atomic 326 bonding 370 Gaussian type 395 orbital angular momentum 326 total 352 orbital angular momentum quantum number 302 orbital approximation 336 orbital energy variation 376 orbital notation 421 order of group 416 order of reaction 796 order–disorder transition 131 ordinary differential equation 971 ore reduction 215 orientation polarization 626 Orion nebula 439 ortho-hydrogen 452 orthogonal function 265, 282 orthogonality 265, 282 orthonormal 283 orthorhombic unit cell 699 oscillator strength 511 osmometry 156 osmosis 156 osmotic pressure 156 osmotic virial coefficient 157 Ostwald viscometer 666 Ostwald’s dilution law 764 Otto cycle 116 outer Helmholtz plane 932 outer potential 934 overall order 796 overall partition function 599 Overbeek, J.T.G. 683 Overhauser effect spectroscopy 548 overlap, symmetry relation 421 overlap density 370 overlap integral 371, 375 overpotential 938 overtone 456 oxidant 216 oxidation 216 oxidative phosphorylation 225, 227 oxygen electronic states 483 molecular properties 483 ozone 853 P p band 725 P branch 458 p orbital 332 real form 333 p-type semiconductivity 726 P680 857 P700 858 packing fraction 716 PAGE 664 para-hydrogen 452 parabolic potential 291, 452 parallel band 461 parallel beta-sheet 678 parallel spins 347 paramagnetic 377, 734 paramagnetic contribution 521 paramagnetism 376 parcel (of air) 12 parity 372, 482 parity selection rule 483 partial charge 379 partial derivative 39, 968 partial differential equation 973 partial fraction 967, 803 partial molar entropy 94 partial molar Gibbs energy 138 partial molar quantity 136 partial molar volume 137 partial pressure 12 partial vapour pressure 124 partially miscible 149 partially miscible liquids 185 distillation 187 particle in a box 278 partition function 568 quantum number 280 particle in a sphere 304 particle on a ring 297 particle on a sphere 301 particular solution 971 partition function canonical 578 contributions to 615 electronic 597 enthalpy 590 entropy 575, 589 equally spaced levels 563 equation of state 604 equilibrium constant 611 factorization 569 Gibbs energy 591 heat capacity 601 Helmholtz energy 590 internal energy 573, 589 molar 591 molecular 564, 591 overall 599 particle in a box 568 pressure 590 rate constant 882 rotational 592 second virial coefficient 605 standard molar 611 thermodynamic functions from 616 thermodynamic information 578 translational 568, 592 two-level system 564 vibrational 596 partition ratio 779 pascal 4, 961 Pascal’s triangle 526 Paschen series 320 INDEX 1049 passive transport 770 patch clamp technique 771 patch electrode 771 path function 57 Patterson synthesis 709 Pauli exclusion principle 337 Pauli principle 338, 451 Pauling electronegativity 379, (T) 1012 PDT 861 PEMD pulse sequence 543 penetration 286, 296, 340 peptide link 571, 667, 675 peptizing agent 682 perfect elastomer 673 perfect gas 8 enthalpy of mixing 143 entropy change 79, 87 entropy of mixing 143 equilibria 202 Gibbs energy 107 Gibbs energy of mixing 142 internal energy 574 isothermal expansion 87 molar volume 11 statistical entropy 580 transport properties 757, 784 perfect-gas temperature scale 6 periodicity 341 peripheral protein 687 permanent waving 681 permittivity 110, 627, 984, 986 perpendicular band 461 persistence length 75 perturbation theory 310, 313 polarizability 625 time-dependent 311 time-independent 310 Petit, A.-T. 247 phaeophytin 857 phase 117, 174 phase (wave) 983 phase boundary 118, 126 phase diagram 118 carbon dioxide 120 helium 121 ice 121 liquid crystal 190 liquid–liquid 185 liquid–solid 189 sodium and potassium 192 water 120, 177 phase problem 709 phase rule 176 phase separation 185 phase transition 117, 129 entropy of 87 phase-sensitive detection 550 phosphatidyl choline 686 phosphine decomposition 927 phospholipid 199, 686 phosphorescence 492, 494, 846 photocatalyst 861 photocathode 473 photochemical processes 845 photochemistry 845 photodeflection 502 photodiode 473 photodissociation 502 photodynamic therapy 860 photoelectric effect 250 photoelectron 378 photoelectron spectroscopy 378, 912 photoemission spectroscopy 912 photoionization 501 photoisomerization 502 photomultiplier tube 473 photon 250 photophosphorylation 858 photosensitization 860 photosphere 346 photosynthesis 856 photosystem I and II 856 phototactic response 713 photovoltaic cell detector 473 physical quantity 959 physical state 3 physisorption 916 pi bond 365 pi orbital 374 pi-bond formation energy 390 pi-electron bonding energy 390 pi pulse 538 pi-stacking interaction 638 pi*-n transition 489 pi*-pi transition 489 pi/2 pulse 534 Planck distribution 246 Planck, M. 246 Planck’s constant 246 plane polarized 491, 984 plane separation 701 plasma 755, 925 plasmid 289 plasmon 925 plastic 674 plastic deformation 721 plastoquinone 858 PMT 473 Pockels cell 498 point dipole 629 point group 405 point group notation 408 Poiseuille’s formula 760 Poisson’s equation 168, 986 Poisson’s ratio 722 polar bond 379 polar coordinates 258, 301 polar molecule 411, 621 polarizability 449, 624, (T) 1015 frequency dependence 626 polarizability volume 624, (T) 1015 polarizable electrode 940 polarization 623 polarization (radiation) 491 polarization mechanism 528, 553 polarization overpotential 941 polarized light 491 polaron 674 polyacetylene 674 polyacrylamide gel electrophoresis 664 polyatomic molecule MO description 386 VB description 365 vibration 460 polychromatic source 470 polychromator 471 polydisperse 653 polydispersity index 654 polyelectrolyte 680 polyelectronic atom 320 polyene 281 polymer 652 polymerization kinetics 835 polymorph 121 polynucleotide 679 polypeptide 667, 677 helix–coil transition 818 polypeptide conformation transition 571 polypeptide melting 134 polytype 715 population 81, 561 population inversion 496 porphine 319, 429 position operator 263 positronium 359 postulates 272 potassium–bromine reaction 875 potential difference 987 potential energy 9, 979 potential energy operator 263 potential energy profile 809 potential energy surface 887 powder diffraction pattern 707 powder diffractometer 703 power 979 working cell 946 power output (laser) 498 power series 967 pre-equilibrium 815 pre-exponential factor 807 pre-exponential factor (T) 1021 prebiotic reactions 829 precession 514, 534 precision-specified transition 501 precursor state 922 predissociation 495 prefixes for units 960, 961 preparation period 543 pressure 4 adiabatic process 48 and altitude 12 critical 17 hydrostatic 5 internal 60, 104 kinetic 609 kinetic model 748 partition function 590 variation with reaction 792 pressure gauge 5 pressure jump 805 pressure units 4 primary absorption 846 primary kinetic isotope effect 816 primary process 845 primary quantum yield 847 primary structure 667 primitive unit cell 697, 699 principal axis 405, 444 principal quantum number 326 principle Avogadro’s 7 building-up 340 equal a priori probabilities 561 equipartition 247 exclusion 337 Franck–Condon 484, 896 Le Chatelier’s 210 Pauli 338, 451 Ritz combination 321 uncertainty 269, 271 variation 380 principle of corresponding states 21 principle of equal a priori probabilities 561 probability amplitude 256 probability density 256, 260, 974 probability theory 973 product rule 966 projection reconstruction 540 prolate 444 promotion 365 propagation step 572, 831 protein crystallization 712 protein folding problem 675 proteomics 664 proton decoupling 541 proton pump 772 pseudo first-order reaction 797 psi 4 pulse technique 533 pulsed beam 928 pulsed-field electrophoresis 664 pumping 496 pure shear 721 pyroelectric detector 473 p–n junction 727 Q Q branch 458, 459 Q-switching 498 QCM 916 QSAR 638 QSSA 812 quadrupole 631 quantitative structure–activity relationships 638 quantity calculus 7 quantization 1050 INDEX angular momentum 298 energy 246, 260 space 307 quantum defect 347 quantum dot 306 quantum mechanics 242 quantum number angular momentum 302 magnetic 302 nuclear spin 515 orbital angular momentum 302 particle in a box 280 principal 326 spin 308 spin magnetic 308 total angular momentum 352 total orbital angular momentum 352 total spin 352 quantum oscillation 641 quantum yield 859 quartz crystal microbalance 916 quartz–tungsten–halogen lamp 470 quasi-steady-state approximation 812 quaternary structure 668 quenching 849 quenching method 794 quinoline 407 quotient rule 966 R R branch 458 radial distribution function atom 331 liquid 606 radial wave equation 322 radial wavefunction 323 radiation, black-body 245 radiation source 470 radiative decay 492 radical chain reaction 830 radio region 244, 984 radius hydrodynamic 766 most probable 332 Stokes 766 radius of gyration 658, 671, (T) 1016 radius of shear 683 radius ratio 717 rainbow angle 641 RAIRS 913 Ramachandran plot 676 Raman activity 468 Raman imaging 473 Raman spectra polyatomic molecule 464 rotational 449 vibrational 459 Raman spectroscopy 431, 500 Ramsperger, H.C. 821 random coil 668 random walk 781 Raoult, F. 144 Raoult’s law 144, 179 rate charge transfer 934 surface process 922 rate constant (T) 1020 diffusion controlled 878 electron transfer 895 Kassel form 821 partition function 882 state-to-state 887 rate law 795 heterogeneous catalysis 927 rate of adsorption 916 rate of formation 794 rate of reaction 794 rate-determining step 814 Rayleigh radiation 431 Rayleigh ratio 657, 691 Rayleigh scattering 657 Rayleigh, Lord 245 Rayleigh–Jeans law 245 RDS 814 reaction centre 856 reaction coordinate 809 reaction enthalpy 51 from enthalpy of formation 55 measurement 212 temperature dependence 56 reaction entropy 93 reaction Gibbs energy 100, 201, 220 reaction mechanism 791 reaction order 796 reaction product imaging 886 reaction profile 809 reaction quotient 202 reaction rate 794 collision theory 809, 870 temperature dependence 807 reactive collision 886 reactive cross-section 871, 874 read gradient 540 real gas 8, 14 real-time analysis 793 reciprocal identity 70 recursion relation 292 redox couple 216 redox reaction 216 reduced mass 322, 752 reduced representation 414 reduced variable 21 reducing agent 216 reductant 216 reference electrode 939 reference state 54 refinement 710 reflected wave 287 reflection 406 reflection (X-ray) 704 reflection-absorption infrared spectroscopy 913 reflection symmetry 483 reforming 931 refraction 984 refractive index 732, 984, (T) 1023 refrigeration 85 regular solution 162, 186 relation between Q and q 579 relative mean speed 752 relative motion 357 relative permittivity 110, 627 relativistic effect 276 relaxation effect 769 relaxation method 805 relaxation time 536, 539 REMPI 886 reorganization energy 897 representation 414 representative matrix 413 repulsion 637 repulsive surface 890 residual entropy 93, 609 resolution (microscopy) 466 resolution (spectroscopy) 473 resonance 513 resonance condition 516 resonance energy transfer 851, 863 resonance integral 380 resonance Raman spectroscopy 465 resonant mode (laser) 497 resonant multiphoton ionization 886 respiratory chain 226 restoring force elastomer 673 resultant vector 964 retardation step 831 retinal 490, 853 retinol 491 reversible change 35 reversible expansion 36 rheology 721 rheometer 666 rhodamine 6G 508 rhodopsin 490 ribosome 840 ribozyme 840 Rice, O.K. 821 Rice–Herzfeld mechanism 830 ridge (atmospheric) 12 rigid rotor 442 Rise–Ramsperger–Kassel model 821 Ritz combination principles 321 RNA 680, 840 rock-salt structure 717 rods and cones 490 Röntgen, W. 702 root mean square deviation 270 root mean square distance 781 root mean square separation 670 root mean square speed 9, 749 rotating frame 534 rotating rheometer 666 rotational constant 443 rotational energy level 443 rotational line intensity 448 rotational motion 297 rotational Raman spectra 449 rotational spectrum 448 rotational structure 487 rotational temperature 594 rotational term 443 rotational transitions 446 rotor 442 RRK model 821, 824 RRKM model 821 rubber 694 ruby glass 682 rule exclusion 464 gross selection 436 Hund’s 341 lever 181 phase 176 Schultze–Hardy 684 selection 335, 356, 423 specific selection 436 Trouton’s 88 Walden’s 776 Runge–Kutta method 972 Russell–Saunders coupling 354 ruthenocene 411 Rydberg atom 360 Rydberg constant 320, 327 Rydberg molecule 401 Rydberg state 347 Rydberg, J. 320 S s band 725 S branch 459 s orbital 328 Sackur–Tetrode equation 580 sacrificial anode 950 saddle point 888 SALC 422 salt bridge 216 salting-in effect 173 salting-out effect 173 SAM 690, 914 SATP 11 saturable absorber 498 Sayre probability relation 710 scalar coupling constant 524 scalar product 350, 514, 965 scanning Auger electron microscopy 914 scanning electron microscopy 254 scanning probe microscopy 289 scanning tunnelling microscopy 289 Scatchard equation 156 scattering factor 706 scattering theory 891 SCF 119, 344, 393 Scherrer, P. 703 Schoenflies system 406 Schrödinger equation one dimensional 254 particle on a sphere 301 INDEX 1051 three-dimensional 255 time-dependent 255 time-independent 254 vibrating molecule 453 Schultze–Hardy rule 684 Schumann–Runge band 510 screening constant (T) 1009 screw axis 910 screw dislocation 910 scuba diving 147 SDS-PAGE 665 second explosion limit 833 second harmonic generation 922 second ionization energy 342 Second Law of thermodynamics 76 second radiation constant 275 second virial coefficient (T) 991 partition function 605 second-order correction 310 second-order phase transition 130 second-order reaction 801 secondary kinetic isotope effect 816 secondary process 845 secondary-ion mass spectrometry 913 secular 380 secular determinant 382 secular equation 380 sedimentation 660 sedimentation constant 661 sedimentation equilibrium 662 selection rule 473 atom 335 diatomic molecules 483 infrared 474 Laporte 483 many-electron atom 356 microwave transition 474 molecular vibration 454 normal mode 467 parity 483 rotational 447 rotational Raman 449 symmetry considerations 423 vibrational Raman 459, 476 vibrations 473 selectivity coefficient 230 selectivity filter 771 self-assembled monolayer 670 self-assembly 681 self-consistent field 344, 393 SEM 254 semi-empirical method 394 semiconductor 723, 726 semipermeable membrane 154 separation of motion 357 separation of variables 284, 358, 973 atom 322 sequencing 668 SERS 913 SEXAFS 914 SFC 119 shape-selective catalyst 927 SHE 222 shear 721 shear modulus 722 shell 328 SHG 922 shielded Coulomb potential 167 shielded nuclear charge 339 shielding 339 electronegativity 522 local contribution 521 shielding constant atom 339 NMR 518 short-range order 606 SI 960 side-centred unit cell 699 siemens 762 sigma bond 364 sigma electron 370 sigma orbital 369, 373 sign convention 33 signal enhancement (NOE) 543 similarity transformation 977 simple distillation 183 SIMS 913 simultaneous equations 976 single-molecule spectroscopy 504 single-valued function 259 single-walled nanotube 720, 728 singlet state 347 singlet–singlet energy transfer 846 SIR model 867 Slater determinant 339, 392 slice selection 540 slip plane 723 smectic phase 189 smoke 682 sodium D lines 351 solar radiation 463 solder 191 solid-state NMR 548 solid–liquid boundary 126 solid–vapour boundary 129 soliton 674 solubility 153 solute activity 159 solution, enthalpy of 51 solvation, Gibbs energy of 110 solvent-accessible surface 396 solvent contribution 521, 524 sp hybrid 367 sp2 hybrid 367 sp3 hybrid 366 space group 405 space lattice 697 space quantization 307 spatial coherence 497 specific enthalpy 52 specific heat capacity 39 specific selection rule 436 specific volume (polymer) 674 spectral regions 244 spectrometer 431, 470, 517, 549 spectrophotometry 792 spectroscopic transition 249 spectroscopy 248, 431 spectrum 249 speed 980 distribution 749 drift 765, 774 mean 751, 752 most probable 752 relative mean 752 root mean square 749 speed of light 243 sphalerite 717 spherical harmonic 302 spherical polar coordinates 168, 258, 301 spherical rotor 442 spin 308 total 352 spin correlation 341 spin density 552 spin echo 539 spin label 554, 686 spin magnetic quantum number 308 spin packet 539 spin paired 337 spin probe 554 spin quantum number 308 spin relaxation 536 spin-1 /2 nucleus 517 spin–lattice relaxation time 536 spin–orbit coupling 348 spin–orbit coupling constant 350 spin–spin coupling 528 spin–spin relaxation time 538 spiral growth 911 spiral ramp 910 SPM 289 spontaneity, criteria for 95 spontaneous 76 spontaneous cooling 86 spontaneous emission 434 SPR 925 square square well 283 SQUID 735 stability parameter 571 standard ambient temperature and pressure 11 standard boiling point 118 standard chemical potential 141 standard emf 220 determination 222 standard enthalpy change 49 standard enthalpy of formation 54 standard enthalpy of fusion 50 standard enthalpy of transition 50 standard enthalpy of vaporization 49, 50 standard entropy 93 standard freezing point 120 standard Gibbs energy of formation 204 standard Gibbs energy of reaction 100 standard hydrogen electrode 222 standard model (stellar structure) 790 standard molar partition function 611 standard potential 222, (T) 1005 combining 222 equilibrium constant 228 standard pressure 4 standard reaction enthalpy 51 standard reaction entropy 93 standard reaction Gibbs energy 202, 220 standard state 49 biological 161, 209 standard state summary 158 standard temperature and pressure 11 star 346 Stark effect 446, 621 Stark modulation 446 state function 31, 57 entropy 82 state-to-state cross-section 887 state-to-state dynamics 886 state-to-state reaction dynamics 501 statistical entropy 81, 575 perfect gas 580 statistical thermodynamics 560 statistics 973 steady-state approximation 812, 831 steam distillation 184 Stefan–Boltzmann law 275 stellar interior 755 stellar structure 346, 755, 790 step 910 stepwise polymerization 835 steric factor 874 steric requirement 873 Stern model 933 Stern, O. 307 Stern–Gerlach experiment 307 Stern–Volmer equation 849 Stern–Volmer plot 850 steroid binding 639 sticking probability 923 stimulated absorption 434 stimulated emission 434, 846 stimulated Raman spectroscopy 501 Stirling’s approximation 563, 974 STM 289 stoichiometric coefficient 203 stoichiometric number 203 Stokes formula 765 Stokes radiation 431 Stokes radius 766 Stokes’ law 775 Stokes–Einstein equation 775, 878 Stokes–Einstein relation 660 stopped-flow technique 793 STP 11 1052 INDEX strain 721 stratosphere 853 stress 721 strong electrolyte 762 strongly coupled spectra 532 structure factor (X-ray) 706 structure factor (light scattering) 657 structure refinement 710 sublimation enthalpy of 51 sublimation vapour pressure 118 subshell 328 subshell energies 340 substance 959 substrate 840, 909 sulfur dioxide spectrum 484 Sun 754 supercoiled DNA 680 superconducting magnet 517 superconducting quantum interference device 735 superconductor 723, 736 supercooled 645 supercritical carbon dioxide 119 supercritical fluid 17, 118 supercritical fluid chromatography 119 supercritical water 119 superfluid 121 superheated 645 superoxide ion 385 superposition 267, 364 superradiant 507 supersaturated 645 supersonic beam 647 supersonic nozzle 648 supertwist 189 surface composition 688, 911 surface defect 910 surface excess 688 surface film balance 687 surface Gibbs energy 688 surface growth 910 surface plasmon resonance 925 surface potential 934 surface pressure 687 surface reconstruction 915 surface tension 642, 689, (T) 1016 surface-enhanced Raman scattering 913 surface-extended X-ray absorption fine structure spectroscopy 914 surfactant accumulation 689 surroundings 28 entropy change 79 susceptibility 522 sweating 53 SWNT 720, 728 symmetric rotor 442, 444 symmetric stretch 461 symmetry and degeneracy 286 symmetry axis 405 symmetry element 404 symmetry number 595 symmetry operation 404 symmetry species 415, 416 symmetry-adapted linear combination 422 synchrotron radiation 470, 713 synchrotron storage ring 470 system 28 one-component 177 systematic absences 707 Système International 4 T T1-weighted image 540 T2-weighted image 541 T3 law 91 Tafel plot 939 Taylor expansion 967 Taylor series 967 TDS 924 Teller, E. 920 TEM 253 Temkin isotherm 922 temperature 5 characteristic rotational 594 characteristic vibrational 597 consolute 186 critical solution 186 Curie 736 Debye 248 Einstein 248 infinite 567, 584 Krafft 685 Néel 736 negative 584 temperature conversion 7 temperature jump 805 temperature scale, thermodynamic 86 temperature-independent paramagnetism 736 temperature–composition diagram 182 temporal coherence 497 tensile strength 723 term, atomic 321 term symbol atom 352 diatomic molecules 482 termination step 831 terrace 910 tertiary structure 668 tesla 514 tetragonal unit cell 699 tetrahedral group 410 theorem equipartition 31, 600 Koopmans’ 378 Nernst heat 92 virial 296 theoretical plate 183 theory activated complex 880 Debye–Hückel 164, 167, 222 Debye–Hückel–Onsager 769 Förster 852 Marcus 896 transition state 880 thermal analysis 178, 191 thermal conduction 747 thermal conductivity 758, 759, 785 thermal de Broglie wavelength 570 thermal desorption spectroscopy 924 thermal equilibrium 6 thermal explosion 833 thermal motion 29 thermal neutrons 714 thermal wavelength 570 thermochemical equation 51 thermochemistry 49 thermodynamic data: inorganic (T) 995 organic (T) 993 thermodynamic equation of state 104 thermodynamic equilibrium constant 205 thermodynamic force 772 thermodynamic function, electrochemical determination 230 thermodynamic limit 577 thermodynamic temperature scale 6, 86 thermodynamics 28 First Law 32 Second Law 76 Third Law 93 Zeroth Law 6 thermogram 43 thermolysis 831 thermometer 6 thermosphere 854 theta-solution 659 theta-temperature 659 third explosion limit 833 Third Law of thermodynamics 93 Third-Law entropy 93, 575 Thomson equation 127 three-level laser 496 tie line 181 tight-binding approximation 724 time constant 801 time-dependent perturbation theory 311, 315 time-dependent Schrödinger equation 255 time-domain signal 536 time-independent perturbation theory 310, 313 time-independent Schrödinger equation 254 time-of-flight spectrometer 655 time-resolved spectroscopy 503 time-resolved X-ray diffraction 713 TIP 736 titanium ion spectrum 488 TMS 519 TOF 655 tonne 961 torque 981 torr 4 Torricelli 4 total angular momentum 349 total angular momentum quantum number 352 total energy 979 total orbital angular momentum quantum number 352 total rate of absorption 434 total spin quantum number 352 TPD 924 trajectory 980 trajectory on surface 888 trans-retinal 490 transcendental equation 186 transfer coefficient 937, (T) 1023 transfer RNA 680 transition 335 charge-transfer 489 cooperative 572 enthalpy of 50 helix–coil 571, 818 polypeptide conformation 571 spectroscopic 249 transition dipole interaction 729 transition dipole moment 312, 335, 435, 473, 484 symmetry considerations 424 transition metal 342 transition rate 312 transition state 809, 881, 888 transition state theory 880 transition temperature 87, 117 translational motion 277 transmission coefficient 881 transmission electron microscopy 253 transmission probability 287 transmittance 432 transmitted wave 287 transport number 768 transport properties 747, (T) 1018 kinetic theory 758 perfect gas 757, 784 transpose matrix 975 transverse relaxation time 537 trial wavefunction 380 triclinic unit cell 699 tridiagonal determinant 724 trigonal unit cell 699 trihydrogen molecule ion 429 triple point 86, 120 triplet state 494 vector diagram 347 triplet–triplet energy transfer 846 tRNA 680 INDEX 1053 tropopause 12, 853 troposphere 11, 853 trough (atmospheric) 12 Trouton’s rule 88 tunnelling 286, 296, 817, 896 turnover frequency 842 two-dimensional box 283 two-dimensional electrophoresis 665 two-dimensional NMR 543 two-level system 564, 573 Type I and II superconductor 737 U u subscript 372 ubiquitin (thermogram) 43 UHV 911 ultracentrifugation 660 ultracentrifuge 661 ultrafast techniques 892 ultrahigh vacuum technique 911 ultrapurity 192 ultraviolet 244 ultraviolet catastrophe 246 ultraviolet photoelectron spectroscopy 378, 913 ultraviolet radiation 855 ultraviolet region 984 uncertainty principle 269 uncompetitive inhibition 845 undetermined multiplier 970 undetermined multipliers 582 ungerade symmetry 372 uniaxial stress 721 unimolecular reaction 810, 820 unique rate of reaction 794 unit 959 unit cell 698 unit cell volume 743 unit matrix 975 unit vector 964 upper critical solution temperature 186 UPS 378, 912, 913 uranium isotope separation 502 urea 53 US standard atmosphere 12 UVB 855 V vacuum permittivity 986 vacuum ultraviolet 244 valence band 726 valence bond theory 362, 363 van der Waals coefficients 18, (T) 992 van der Waals equation 17, 19 fugacity coefficient 112 internal pressure 105 van der Waals interaction 629 van der Waals isotherms 20 van der Waals loops 20 van der Waals molecule 641 van der Waals, J.D. 17 van ’t Hoff equation (equilibrium) 212 van ’t Hoff equation (osmosis) 156 vanishing integral 419, 423 vaporization enthalpy of 49, 50 entropy of 88 vapour composition 179 vapour diffusion method 712 vapour pressure 17, 118 curved surface 645 decomposition 206 effect of applied pressure 124 partial 124 variation with composition 179 vapour pressure lowering 150 variance 176 variation principle 380 VB theory 362 vector 964 vector addition 964 vector algebra 964 vector diagram parallel spins 347 spin paired 337 triplet state 347 vector model 308 vector multiplication 965 vector product 965 vector representation 300 velocity 980 velocity selector 647, 753 vertical transition 484 Verwey, E. 683 vibration 452 vibrational microscopy 466 vibrational modes 460 vibrational motion 290 vibrational partition function 596 vibrational progression 485 vibrational Raman spectra 459 vibrational term 453 vibrational wavenumber (T) 1013 vibration–rotation spectra 457 vibronic laser 731 vibronic transition 484 virial 609 virial coefficient 16 virial equation of state 16, 19 virial theorem 296 viscosity 665, 747, 758, 759, 761, 785, (T) 1019 diffusion coefficient 775 viscosity-average molar mass 653 visible region 984 vision 490 vitamin C 386 volcano curve 929 voltammetry 940 volume magnetic susceptibility 734 von Laue, M. 702 W Walden’s rule 776 Wannier exciton 729 water conduction in 766 entropy of vaporization 89 phase diagram 120, 177 radial distribution function 606 residual entropy 610 supercritical 119 superfluid phase 122 triple point 86, 120 VB description 365 vibrations 461 viscosity 761 Watson, J. 711 watt 961, 979 wave 983 wave equation 983 wave packet 269 wavefunction 253, 272 acceptability 259 acceptable 272 antisymmetric 338 constraints 259 harmonic oscillator 291 hydrogen 324 interpretation 256 linear momentum 261 particle in a box 280 particle on a rectangular surface 285 radial 323 separation 322 trial 380 wavelength 244 wavenumber 244, 983 wavepacket 892 wave–particle duality 253 weak acid 763 weak electrolyte 763, 764 weather 11 weather map 12 weight (configuration) 562 weight-average molar mass 652 wet 644 white paper 658 wide-field epifluorescence method 504 Wierl equation 742 Wilkins, M. 711 wind 11, 12 work 29 additional 34, 99 against constant pressure 35 electrical 34 expansion 33 gas production 36 general expression 33 maximum 96 maximum non-expansion 99 nonexpansion 34 surface expansion 34 varieties of 34 work function 301 wrinkle, Nature’s abhorrence of 777 X X-ray 702 X-ray crystallography 711 X-ray diffraction 702 X-ray fluorescence 914 X-ray photoelectron spectroscopy 912 X-ray region 244, 984 xanthophyll 490 xenon discharge lamp 470 XPS 912 Y yield point 723 Young’s modulus 722 Z Z-average molar mass 653 Zeeman effect 360 zeolite 931 zero-order reaction 796 zero-point energy 281, 291 Zeroth Law of thermodynamics 6 zeta potential 683 Zimm–Bragg model 572 zinc blende 717 zipper model 572 zone levelling 191 zone refining 190